Official Software
Toyota - 4Runner - Wiring Diagram - 2007 - 2007
£9.99
Get your hands on the complete Toyota factory workshop software
Download now
Check out our popular Toyota Other Model Manuals below:
Get your hands on the Complete Toyota Factory Workshop Software
Download now9.99
Summary of Content
2007 4RUNNER
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
Section Code
Page
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A . . . .
2
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B . . . .
3
TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C . . . .
12
ABBREVIATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D . . . .
17
GLOSSARY OF TERMS AND SYMBOLS . . . . . E . . . .
18
RELAY LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F . . . .
20
ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING . . . . . . . . . . . G . . . .
32
SYSTEM CIRCUITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H . . . .
52
GROUND POINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I . . . .
368
POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart) . . . . . J . . . .
376
CONNECTOR LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . K . . . .
386
PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS . . . . . . . . . L . . . .
406
OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM . M . . . .
412
1
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A INTRODUCTION
This manual consists of the following 13 sections:
No.
Section
Description
INDEX
Index of the contents of this manual.
INTRODUCTION
Brief explanation of each section.
B
HOW TO USE THIS
MANUAL
Instructions on how to use this manual.
C
TROUBLE–
SHOOTING
Describes the basic inspection procedures for electrical circuits.
D
ABBREVIATIONS
Defines the abbreviations used in this manual.
E
GLOSSARY OF
TERMS AND
SYMBOLS
Defines the symbols and functions of major parts.
F
RELAY LOCATIONS
Shows position of the Electronic Control Unit, Relays, Relay Block, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
G
ELECTRICAL
WIRING ROUTING
Describes position of Parts Connectors, Splice points, Ground points, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
INDEX
Index of the system circuits.
SYSTEM CIRCUITS
Electrical circuits of each system are shown from the power supply through ground
points. Wiring connections and their positions are shown and classified by code
according to the connection method. (Refer to the section, ”How to use this manual”).
The ”System Outline” and ”Service Hints” useful for troubleshooting are also contained
in this section.
(Only wiring information for complete circuits is included.)
I
GROUND POINT
Shows ground positions of all parts described in this manual.
J
POWER SOURCE
(Current Flow Chart)
Describes power distribution from the power supply to various electrical loads.
K
CONNECTOR LIST
Describes the form of the connectors for the parts appeared in this book.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
L
PART NUMBER OF
CONNECTORS
Indicates the part number of the connectors used in this manual.
M
OVERALL
ELECTRICAL
WIRING DIAGRAM
Provides circuit diagrams showing the circuit connections.
(Only wiring information for complete circuits is included.)
A
H
2
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
FOREWORD
This wiring diagram manual has been prepared to provide
information on the electrical system of the 2007 4RUNNER.
Applicable models: UZN210, 215 Series
GRN210, 215 Series
Refer to the following manuals for additional service
specifications and repair procedures for these models:
Manual Name
D 2007 4RUNNER Repair Manual
D 2007 TOYOTA New Car Features
Pub. No.
RM03M0U
NM04J0U
All information in this manual is based on the latest product
information at the time of publication. However, specifications
and procedures are subject to change without notice.
NOTICE
Always follow the directions given in the above repair manuals when handling
supplemental restraint system components (such as removal, installation,
inspection, etc.) in order to prevent accidents and supplemental restraint
system malfunction.
E2006
All rights reserved. This book may not be
reproduced or copied, in whole or in part, without
the written permission of Toyota Motor
Corporation.
First Printing : Jul. 06, 2006 01–060706–00
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL B
This manual provides information on the electrical circuits installed on vehicles by
dividing them into a circuit for each system.
The actual wiring of each system circuit is shown from the point where the power
source is received from the battery as far as each ground point. (All circuit
diagrams are shown with the switches in the OFF position.)
When troubleshooting any problem, first understand the operation of the circuit
where the problem was detected (see System Circuit section), the power source
supplying power to that circuit (see Power Source section), and the ground points
(see Ground Point section). See the System Outline to understand the circuit
operation.
When the circuit operation is understood, begin troubleshooting of the problem
circuit to isolate the cause. Use Relay Location and Electrical Wiring Routing
sections to find each part, junction block and wiring harness connectors, wiring
harness and wiring harness connectors and ground points of each system circuit.
Internal wiring for each junction block is also provided for better understanding of
connection within a junction block.
Wiring related to each system is indicated in each system circuit by arrows
(from__, to__). When overall connections are required, see the Overall Electrical
Wiring Diagram at the end of this manual.
3
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
* The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual
circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
[A]
Stop Light
(BAT)
[N]
(IG)
15A
STOP
7.5A
GAUGE
2
[B]
3 IB
4 IB
L
(S/D)
W–R
R–L
1
7 3C
2
[G]
[C]
S6
Stop Light SW
15 3C
14 IE1
8
L4
Light Failure Sensor
4
11
1
(Shielded)
Stop
3
R6
Rear Combination
Light LH
R7
Rear Combination
Light RH
W–B
[J]
G–B
[I]
G–R
G–R
G–R
2
H17
High Mounted
Stop Light
[K]
1
6
W–B
W–B
1
BV1
W–B
W–B
W–B
3
BO
50
Rear
Lights
[F]
G–R
[H]
1
BV1
13
Y–G
L
G–W
(S/D)
G–W
2
Stop
[E]
[L]
BL
[M]
4
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C7
Combination Meter
4
15 IE1
7
4
R–L
L
(S/D)
R
G–W
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
[D]
(W/G)
1
B
[A] : System Title
[H] : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
[B] : Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish it
from the J/B
Example:
Indicates Relay Block No.1
B
= Black
W = White
BR = Brown
L
= Blue
V
SB = Sky Blue
= Violet
R = Red
G = Green
LG = Light Green
[C] : (
) is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine
type, or specification is different.
P
Y
GR = Gray
[D] : Indicates related system.
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
= Pink
= Yellow
O = Orange
[E] : Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male terminal is
shown with arrows (
).
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
Example:
L–Y
L
(Blue)
[I]
Female
Male (
)
Y
(Yellow)
: Indicates a wiring Splice Point
Example:
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness
and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component’s location, e.g, ”E” for the Engine
Compartment, ”I” for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and ”B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second
letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g, IH1,
IH2), this indicates the same type of wiring harness
and wiring harness connector.
[F] : Represents a part (all parts are shown in sky blue).
The code is the same as the code used in parts
position.
[G] : Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B
No. and the connector code is shown beside it).
Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts.
[J] : Indicates a shielded cable.
[K] : Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and
male connectors.
Example: Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Example:
3C indicates that
it is inside
Junction Block
No.3
Female
Male
[L] : Indicates a ground point.
The first letter of the code for each ground point(s)
indicates the component’s location, e.g, ”E” for the
Engine Compartment, ”I” for the Instrument Panel
and Surrounding area, and ”B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
[M] : Page No.
[N] : Indicates the ignition key position(s) when the
power is supplied to the fuse(s).
5
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
[O]
System Outline
Current is applied at all times through the STOP fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and also flows
through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
Stop Light Disconnection Warning
When the ignition SW is turned on and the brake pedal is pressed (Stop light SW on), if the stop light circuit is open, the current
flowing from TERMINAL 7 of the light failure sensor to TERMINALS 1, 2 changes, so the light failure sensor detects the
disconnection and the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear lights
warning light on. By pressing the brake pedal, the current flowing to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor keeps the warning
circuit on and holds the warning light on until the ignition SW is turned off.
[P]
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C7
34
L4
36
R7
37
H17
36
R6
37
S6
35
[Q]
: Relay Blocks
Code
1
[R]
See Page
18
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
R/B No.1 (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
3C
22
Instrument Panel Wire and J/B No.3 (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
IB
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
[S]
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
42
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
BV1
50
Luggage Room Wire and Floor Wire (Luggage Room Left)
[T]
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
BL
50
Under the Left Center Pillar
BO
50
Back Panel Center
6
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B
[O] : Explains the system outline.
[P] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of the parts in the system circuit.
Example : Part ”L4” (Light Failure Sensor) is on page 36 of the manual.
∗ The letter in the code is from the first letter of the part, and the number indicates its order in parts
starting with that letter.
Example : L 4
Á
Á
Parts is 4th in order
Light Failure Sensor
[Q] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of Relay Block Connectors in the system circuit.
Example : Connector ”1” is described on page 18 of this manual and is installed on the left side of the instrument
panel.
[R] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of J/B and Wire Harness in the system circuit.
Example : Connector ”3C” connects the Instrument Panel Wire and J/B No.3. It is described on page 22 of this
manual, and is installed on the instrument panel left side.
[S] : Indicates the reference page describing the wiring harness and wiring harness connector (the female wiring
harness is shown first, followed by the male wiring harness).
Example : Connector ”IE1” connects the floor wire (female) and Instrument panel wire (male). It is described on
page 42 of this manual, and is installed on the left side kick panel.
[T] : Indicates the reference page showing the position of the ground points on the vehicle.
Example : Ground point ”BO” is described on page 50 of this manual and is installed on the back panel center.
7
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The ground points circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective ground points. When
troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use a common ground may help you identify
the problem ground quickly. The relationship between ground points ( EA , IB and IC shown below) can also be
checked this way.
I GROUND POINT
W–B
W–B
FAN MAIN Relay
5
FAN MAIN Relay
5
A/C Control Assembly
W–B
5
A/C Relay No.3
5
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
Blower Motor
O/D Main SW
W–B
A/C Relay No.2
W–B
A
Cigarette Lighter
A W–B
W–B
Clock
Blower SW
A
W–B
W–B
A
Parking Brake SW
J1
Junction
Connector
W–B
Radiator Fan Motor
7
3B
W–B
Headlight Cleaner Relay
W–B
Combination Meter
W–B
W–B
Headlight LH
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Front Fog Light LH
3
3F
13
3G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Front Turn Signal Light LH
Brake Fluid Level SW
W–B
W–B
5
3E
W–B
6
3E
Front Clearance Light LH
W–B
W–B
Door Lock Control SW
2
IA1
W–B
1
3D
W–B
W–B
Front Clearance Light RH
W–B
Front Fog Light RH
W–B
Front Turn Signal Light RH
W–B
Combination SW
7
3C
W–B
Headlight RH
Cruise Control ECU
Remote Control Mirror SW
Turn Signal Flasher
W–B
W–B
Defogger SW
W–B
Combination SW
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Door Lock Motor RH
W–B
W–B
W–B
Door Courtesy SW RH
W–B
Unlock Warning SW
10 EA2
15 W–B
ID1
W–B
W–B
W–B
Door Lock Control Relay
W–B
Power Window Master SW
W–B
EA
W–B
Idle–Up SW
Door Courtesy SW LH
8 W–B
IB1
Door Lock Control SW
W–B
W–B
W–B
A/C Amplifier
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Blower Resistor
Power Window Control
Relay
Door Lock Motor LH
W–B (4A–GZE)
4
Fuel Control SW
4
4
3
IC3
W–B
W–B
BR
Radio and Player
4
W–B
Woofer Speaker Amplifier
BR
W–B
BR
BR
BR
Combination Meter
4
BR
Fuel Sender
W–B
4
BR
5
BA1
W–B
BR
Auto Antenna Motor
Combination Meter
4
HEATER Relay
IB
*
IC
The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
8
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B
The ”Current Flow Chart” section, describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit breakers)
transmits current to. In the Power Source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery power is supplied to each system
are explained. Since all System Circuit diagrams start from the power source, the power source system must be fully
understood.
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
The chart below shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each electrical source
(Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fues, etc.) and other parts
10A ECU–B
2
2
Short Pin
7.5A DOME
15A EFI
Battery
2
30A AM2
6
Fusible Link Block
10A HAZARD
2
20A RADIO NO.1
S2
Starter
10A HORN
6
100A ALT
5
60A ABS
Engine Room R/B (See Page 20)
20A
10A
Fuse
System
Page
STOP
ABS
ABS and Traction Control
Cruise Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Multiplex Communication System
194
187
180
166
210
DOME
Cigarette Lighter
Combination Meter
Headlight
Interior Light
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off System
Theft Deterrent and Door Lock Control
214
230
112
122
Power Source
B
1
BA1
W
1.25B
FL MAIN
Battery
50A MAIN
B
2
1
7.5A DOME
2
2
W
7
EB1
W
W
1
1
2
R
1
7.5A AM1
2
1
2
2
W–R
6
EB1
W–R
W
B
15A HAZ–RADIO
2
W
8
4
AM2
2
AM1
1
ST2
IG2
ST1
IG1
ACC
I8
Ignition SW
2
20A DEFOG
B–Y
∗
1
1
2
1
W–R
The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
9
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
K CONNECTOR LIST
[A]
I14
I15
I16
Dark Gray
Gray
1 2 3 4
J1
[C]
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
[D]
[B]
J4
K1
Black
K2
L1
1 2
1 2
Dark Gray
A
A A
A A A A A
A B B
DD
A A B CC CDD
1
K CONNECTOR LIST
BA1
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Black
BD2
[E]
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
5 4
3 2 1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6
Gray
[F]
4 3
2 1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5
[A] : Indicates connector to be connected to a part. (The numeral indicates the pin No.)
[B] : Junction Connector
Indicates a connector which is connected to a short terminal.
Junction Connector
Junction connector in this manual include a short terminal which is
connected to a number of wire harnesses. Always perform
inspection with the short terminal installed. (When installing the
wire harnesses, the harnesses can be connected to any position
within the short terminal grouping. Accordingly, in other vehicles,
the same position in the short terminal may be connected to a wire
harness from a different part.)
Wire harness sharing the same short terminal grouping have the
same color.
Same Color
Short Terminal
[C] : Parts Code
The first letter of the code is taken from the first letter of part, and the numbers indicates its order in parts which
start with the same letter.
[D] : Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
[E] : Indicates the connector shapes which are used to join wire harnesses.
On Left : Female connector shapes
On Right : Male connector shapes
Numbers indicate pin numbers.
[F] : Indicates connector colors. (Connectors with not indicated colors are white)
10
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Part Name
Code
Part Number
Code
Part Name
Part Number
A1
A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
90980–11070
D4
Diode (Courtesy)
90980–11608
A2
A/C Condenser Fan Motor
90980–11237
D5
Diode (Interior Light)
90980–10962
A3
A/C Condenser Fan Relay
90980–10940
D6
Diode (Moon Roof)
90980–11608
90980–10848
A4
A/C Condenser Fan Resistor
90980–10928
D7
Door Lock Control Relay
A5
A/C Magnetic Clutch
90980–11271
D8
Door Lock Control SW LH
A6
A/T Oil Temp. Sensor
90980–11413
D9
Door Lock Control SW RH
A7
[A]
ABS Actuator
[B]
90980–11151
[C]
D10
Door Courtesy SW LH
A8
ABS Actuator
90980–11009
D11
Door Courtesy SW RH
90980–11148
90980–11097
A9
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
90980–10941
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
A10
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
90980–11002
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
A11
Airbag Sensor Front LH
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
A12
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A13
Airbag Squib
90980–11156
90980–11856
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
90980–11194
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW LH
90980–11070
D17
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW RH
90980–11170
[A] : Part Code
[B] : Part Name
[C] : Part Number
Toyota Part Number are indicated.
Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply.
11
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C TROUBLESHOOTING
VOLTAGE CHECK
To Ignition SW
IG Terminal
(a) Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check
point.
Example:
[A] – Ignition SW on
[B] – Ignition SW and SW 1 on
[C] – Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (SW 2 off)
Fuse
[A]
SW 1
Voltmeter
[B]
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground
point or negative battery terminal, and the positive lead to the
connector or component terminal.
This check can be done with a test light instead of a voltmeter.
Relay
[C]
Solenoid
SW 2
CONTINUITY AND RESISTANCE CHECK
(a) Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage
between the check points.
Ohmmeter
(b) Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check
points.
SW
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check
again.
When contacting the negative lead to the diode positive side
and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be
continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no
continuity.
Ohmmeter
Diode
Digital Type
Analog Type
(c) Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
12
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C
FINDING A SHORT CIRCUIT
To Ignition SW
IG Terminal
(a) Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse.
(b) Connect a test light in place of the fuse.
(c) Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Test Light
Fuse Case
Short [A]
SW 1
Short [B]
Disconnect
Disconnect
Light
Example:
[A] – Ignition SW on
[B] – Ignition SW and SW 1 on
[C] – Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (Connect the
Relay) and SW 2 off (or Disconnect SW 2)
(d) Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the
test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light
stays lit and the connector where the light goes out.
(e) Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the
problem wire along the body.
Relay
CAUTION:
Short [C]
Disconnect
SW 2
Solenoid
(a) Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals are touched,
the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
(b) When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of
the digital meter, be careful that no part of your body or
clothing comes in contact with the terminals of leads
from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
DISCONNECTION OF MALE AND FEMALE
CONNECTORS
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not
the wire harness.
HINT : Check to see what kind of connector you are
disconnecting before pulling apart.
Pull Up
Pull Up
Press Down
Press Down
13
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO REPLACE TERMINAL
(with terminal retainer or secondary locking device)
Reference:
1. PREPARE THE SPECIAL TOOL
10
3
1
Example:
(Case 1)
1
HINT : To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
0.2
(mm)
Up
3. DISENGAGE THE SECONDARY LOCKING DEVICE OR
Tool
TERMINAL RETAINER.
(a) Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal
locking clip can be released and the terminal removed from
the connector.
(b) Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary
locking device or terminal retainer.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Terminal Retainer
[A]
Terminal Retainer
For Non–Waterproof Type Connector
HINT : The needle insertion position varies according to the
connector’s shape (number of terminals etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
”Case 1”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
position.
Stopper
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Example:
(Case 2)
Secondary
Locking Device
”Case 2”
Open the secondary locking device.
14
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C
Tool
Tab
Tab
Example:
(Case 1)
[B]
Terminal
Retainer
Tool
[Male]
Access Hole
(
Mark)
Tool
For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT : Terminal retainer color is different
according to connector body.
Example:
Terminal Retainer
Black or White
Black or White
Gray or White
: Connector Body
: Gray
: Dark Gray
: Black
[Female]
”Case 1”
Type where terminal retainer is pulled
up to the temporary lock position (Pull
Type).
Insert the special tool into the terminal
retainer access hole (YMark) and pull
the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
Retainer
at Full Lock Position
HINT : The needle insertion position varies
according to the connector’s shape
(Number of terminals etc.), so check
the position before inserting it.
Retainer
at Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
Example:
(Case 2)
[Female]
”Case 2”
Type which cannot be pulled as far as
Power Lock insert the tool straight into
the access hole of terminal retainer as
shown.
Terminal Retainer
Tool
Tool
[Male]
Press Down
Press Down
[Female]
15
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C TROUBLESHOOTING
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Retainer at
Full Lock Position
Retainer at
Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
[Female]
(c) Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out
from rear.
Locking Lug
Tool
4. INSTALL TERMINAL TO CONNECTOR
(a) Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug locks firmly.
3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock
position.
(b) Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to
the full lock position.
5. CONNECT CONNECTOR
16
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ABBREVIATIONS D
ABBREVIATIONS
The following abbreviations are used in this manual.
2WD
4WD
A/C
A/T
ABS
ACIS
ADD
BEAN
CAN
CD
DIFF.
EC
ECU
ESA
ETCS–i
IC
INT
J/B
LH
LSD
R/B
RH
SFI
SPEC.
SRS
SW
TEMP.
TRAC
TVIP
VSC
VSV
VVT
VVT–i
w/
w/o
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
Two Wheel Drive Vehicles
Four Wheel Drive Vehicles
Air Conditioning
Automatic Transmission
Anti–Lock Brake System
Acoustic Control Induction System
Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Body Electronics Area Network
Controller Area Network
Compact Disc
Differential
Electrochromic
Electronic Control Unit
Electronic Spark Advance
Electronic Throttle Control System–intelligent
Integrated Circuit
Intermittent
Junction Block
Left–Hand
Limited Slip Differential
Relay Block
Right–Hand
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Specification
Supplemental Restraint System
Switch
Temperature
Traction Control
TOYOTA Vehicle Intrusion Protection
Vehicle Stability Control
Vacuum Switching Valve
Variable Valve Timing
Variable Valve Timing–intelligent
With
Without
∗ The titles given inside the components are the names of the terminals (terminal codes) and are not treated as being
abbreviations.
17
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
E GLOSSARY OF TERMS AND SYMBOLS
GROUND
The point at which wiring attaches to
the Body, thereby providing a return
path for an electrical circuit; without a
ground, current cannot flow.
BATTERY
Stores chemical energy and
converts it into electrical energy.
Provides DC current for the auto’s
various electrical circuits.
CAPACITOR (Condenser)
A small holding unit for temporary
storage of electrical voltage.
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
An electric resistance heating
element.
HEADLIGHTS
Current flow causes a headlight
1. SINGLE
FILAMENT filament to heat up and emit light. A
headlight may have either a single
(1) filament or a double (2) filament
2. DOUBLE
FILAMENT
CIRCUIT BREAKER
Basically a reusable fuse, a circuit
breaker will heat and open if too
much current flows through it.
Some units automatically reset when
cool, others must be manually reset.
HORN
An electric device which sounds a
loud audible signal.
DIODE
A semiconductor which allows
current flow in only one direction.
IGNITION COIL
Converts low–voltage DC current
into high–voltage ignition current for
firing the spark plugs.
DIODE, ZENER
LIGHT
Current flow through a filament
causes the filament to heat up and
emit light.
A diode which allows current flow in one
direction but blocks reverse flow only up
to a specific voltage. Above that potential,
it passes the excess voltage. This acts as
a simple voltage regulator.
PHOTODIODE
The photodiode is a semiconductor
which controls the current flow
according to the amount of light.
LED (LIGHT EMITTING DIODE)
Upon current flow, these diodes emit
light without producing the heat of a
comparable light.
DISTRIBUTOR, IIA
Channels high–voltage current from
the ignition coil to the individual
spark plugs.
METER, ANALOG
Current flow activates a magnetic
coil which causes a needle to move,
thereby providing a relative display
against a background calibration.
FUSE
METER, DIGITAL
Current flow activates one or many
LED’s, LCD’s, or fluorescent
displays, which provide a relative or
digital display.
A thin metal strip which burns through
when too much current flows through it,
thereby stopping current flow and
protecting a circuit from damage.
FUEL
FUSIBLE LINK
(for Medium Current Fuse)
(for High Current Fuse or
Fusible Link)
A heavy–gauge wire placed in high
amperage circuits which burns through on
overloads, thereby protecting the circuit.
The numbers indicate the crosssection
surface area of the wires.
M
18
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
MOTOR
A power unit which converts
electrical energy into mechanical
energy, especially rotary motion.
E
SPEAKER
An electromechanical device which
creates sound waves from current
flow.
RELAY
Basically, an electrically operated
1. NORMALLYswitch which may be normally
CLOSED closed (1) or open (2).
Current flow through a small coil
creates a magnetic field which either
opens or closes an attached switch.
2. NORMALLY
OPEN
SWITCH, MANUAL
Opens and closes
circuits, thereby
1. NORMALLY
stopping (1) or
OPEN
allowing (2) current
flow.
RELAY, DOUBLE THROW
A relay which passes current
through one set of contacts or the
other.
2. NORMALLY
CLOSED
RESISTOR
An electrical component with a fixed
resistance, placed in a circuit to
reduce voltage to a specific value.
SWITCH, DOUBLE THROW
A switch which continuously passes
current through one set of contacts
or the other.
RESISTOR, TAPPED
A resistor which supplies two or
more different non adjustable
resistance values.
SWITCH, IGNITION
A key operated switch with several
positions which allows various
circuits, particularly the primary
ignition circuit, to become
operational.
RESISTOR, VARIABLE or RHEOSTAT
A controllable resistor with a variable
rate of resistance.
Also called a potentiometer or
rheostat.
(Reed Switch Type)
SENSOR (Thermistor)
A resistor which varies its resistance
with temperature.
SWITCH, WIPER PARK
Automatically returns wipers to the
stop position when the wiper switch
is turned off.
SENSOR, SPEED
Uses magnetic impulses to open
and close a switch to create a signal
for activation of other components.
TRANSISTOR
A solidstate device typically used as
an electronic relay; stops or passes
current depending on the voltage
applied at ”base”.
SHORT PIN
Used to provide an unbroken
connection within a junction block.
SOLENOID
An electromagnetic coil which forms
a magnetic field when current flows,
to move a plunger, etc.
WIRES
Wires are always drawn as
(1) NOT
straight lines on wiring
CONNECTED diagrams.
Crossed wires (1) without a
black dot at the junction are
not joined;
crossed wires (2) with a
black dot or octagonal ( )
(2) SPLICED
mark at the junction are
spliced (joined)
connections.
19
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
[Engine Compartment]
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
Engine Room R/B No.3
Engine Room
R/B
Air Injection
Control Driver
Engine Room R/B No.4
[Body]
Moon Roof Control ECU
Rear Seat Audio Controller
Tire Pressure Warning
Antenna and Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
Towing Converter Relay
Door Control Receiver
20
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Back Door ECU
F
[Instrument Panel]
Transponder Key
Amplifier
Center J/B
Theft Deterrent
ECU
Transponder Key
Computer
Engine Control
Module
4WD Control
ECU
Suspension
Control ECU
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
A/C Control
Assembly
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
Daytime Running
Light Relay
Driver Side J/B
Body ECU
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Shift Lock
Control ECU
[Seat]
Position Control
ECU and SW
Occupant Classification ECU
21
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
2
: Engine Room R/B
Engine Compartment Left (See Page 20)
* 1:ACC CUT Relay
* 2:FR FOG Relay
* 3:STA Relay
* 4:HEATER Relay
* 5:MG CLT Relay
* 6:RADIO NO.1
* 7:C/OPN Relay
* 8:DOME Relay
* 9:EFI Relay
* 10:A/F HEATER Relay
* 11:HEAD (LO LH)
* 12:HEAD (HI LH)
FUEL PUMP Relay
AC115V INV Relay
IG Relay
DEFOG Relay
60A HEATER
(for High Current)
5
1 7.5A 2
OBD
2
3
1 15A 2
FR FOG
1 15A 2
AC115V INV
1 10A 2
STOP
*3
3
5
3
5
1 4 2
1 4 2
1
3
5
1
1
2
2
3
5
3
5
*5
2
1
1
2
RADIO NO.2
2 20A 1
TOWING
2 30A 1
DR/LCK
2 20A 1
2
2
30A BATT CHG
(for High Current)
*2
1
2
1
*4
4
*10
3 5
*9
3 5
*8
3 5
1
5
2
1
1
3
50A J/B
(for High Current)
1
2
30A TOWING BRK
(for High Current)
1
2
50A AM1
(for High Current)
1
2
50A AIR SUS
(for High Current)
1
2
1
2
EFI
2 20A 1
ETCS
2 10A 1
1
2
*1
50A A/PUMP
(for High Current)
3
1 4 2
HEATER NO.2
2 7.5A 1
AIRSUS NO.2
2 10A 1
SEAT HEATER
2 25A 1
DEFOG
2 30A
MIR HEATER 1
2 10A
40A TOWING
(for High Current)
3
5
2
TRN-HAZ
2 15A 1
A/F HEATER
2 15A 1
HORN
2 10A 1
1
ECU-B
10A 2
*6
1 20A 2
DOME
10A 2
3
5
*7
2
1
1
ALT-S
2 7.5A 1
Short Pin
2
1
1
2
1
30A AM2
(for High Current)
2
1
40A ABS MTR
(for High Current)
5
HEAD Relay
2
3
5
2
30A ABS SOL
(for High Current)
2
1 4 2
HEAD (LO RH)
10A 2
1 *11
10A 2
HEAD (HI RH)
10A 2
1 *12
10A 2
EFI NO.2
1 10A 2
140A ALT
(for High Current)
2
3
STOP LP CTRL Relay
22
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
F
3
: Engine Room R/B No.3 Engine Compartment Left (See Page 20)
3
1
4
3
2
1
2
5
5
BATT CHG Relay
TOWING TAIL Relay
: Engine Room R/B No.4 Engine Compartment Left (See Page 20)
3
1
2
5
AIR SUS Relay
23
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
: Driver Side J/B
Lower Finish Panel (See Page 21)
201918 17
16 1514 1312 11
10 9 8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
(from Roof Wire)
1A
10 9 8 7
20 19 18 17
6 5 4 3 2 1
16 15 14 13 12 11
5 4
3 2 1
13 12 1110 9 8 7 6
1B
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
(from Engine Room Main Wire)
4WD
20A
IG1
15A
ECU-IG
10A
CIG
10A
ACC
7.5A
RR WSH
15A
TAIL
10A
30A POWER
(for Medium Current)
1
1C
2
FR WIP-WSH
30A
STA NO.2
7.5A
GAUGE
7.5A
SRS
10A
1
PWR OUTLET
15A
P P/SEAT
30A
D P/SEAT
SECU/HORN
30A
10A
2
1
6 2
5
4
3 1
2
(from Engine Room Main Wire)
1D
IGN
10A
2 6
5
4
1 3
(from Engine Room Main Wire)
12 11 10 9
24 23 22 21
8 7
16 15
6 5 4 3 2 1
18 17 16 15 14 13
6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10 9
1F
16 15
8 7
8 7
20 19
1E
14 13 12 11 10 9
6 5 4 3 2 1
(from Floor No.2 Wire)
24 2322 21
12 1110 9
2019
8 7
181716151413
6 5 4 3 2 1
(from Engine Room Main Wire)
24
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F
Body ECU
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
POWER Relay
DC SKT Relay
TAIL Relay
2
HORN Relay
2
3 5
2
3 5
1
2
3 5
1
3 5
1
1
4
3
2
1
1G
4
3
2
1
(from Instrument
Panel Wire)
1H
1 2
3 4
2 1
4 3
17 18 19 20 21 22
1 2 3 4 5 6
23 24 25 26
7 8 9 10
27 28 29 30 31 32
11 12 13 14 15 16
(from Instrument
Panel Wire)
9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6
1K
16 15
8 7
13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6
15 16
7 8
19 20
7 8
2122 23 24
9 10 11 12
1L
14 13 1211 10 9
6 5 4 3 2 1
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
1 2 3 4 5 6
13 14 15 16 17 18
1J
7 8
19 20
9 10 1112
21 22 23 24
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
32 31 30 29 28 27
16 15 14 13 12 11
26 25 24 23
10 9 8 7
22 21 20 19 18 17
6 5 4 3 2 1
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
25
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
[Driver Side J/B Inner Circuit]
7.5A STA NO.2
3 1D
2 1K
13 1L
4 1K
4 1D
21 1E
15 1L
10 1J
10A IGN
6 1D
2 1L
23 1E
11 1J
7.5A GAUGE
4 1G
1 1J
2 1J
10A SRS
20 1L
3 1H
10 1F
4 1H
10A SECU/HORN
1 1C
10 1K
23 1J
12 1K
7 1E
14 1K
30A P P/SEAT
32 1J
8 1E
30A D P/SEAT
29 1J
24 1J
2 1G
1 1L
30A POWER
1
2
9 1F
POWER Relay
5
3
2
1 1A
1 1H
1
5 1J
25 1J
17 1E
2 1F
18 1E
11 1A
6 1J
3 1G
4 1J
TAIL Relay
5
3
1
10A TAIL
21 1J
9 1B
11 1B
2
15 1F
5 1L
6 1E
13 1F
22 1J
15A PWR OUTLET
9 1A
4 1A
19 1A
DC SKT Relay
3
5
1
2
10 1A
10 1E
30 1J
31 1J
7.5A ACC
8 1K
5 1D
3 1E
16 1E
10A CIG
17 1L
HORN Relay
5
3
1
2
(Cont. Next Page)
26
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1 1D
13 1K
F
(Cont'd)
15A IG1
2 1C
20 1E
1 1E
8 1J
2 1E
2 1A
17 1J
7 1K
10A ECU-IG
18 1J
12 1E
20 1J
28 1J
15 1K
8 1F
16 1L
3 1A
30A FR WIP-WSH
16 1K
22 1E
4 1F
9 1J
4 1B
3 1L
5 1B
11 1F
15A RR WSH
4 1L
12 1B
12 1F
13 1B
14 1J
6 1K
20A 4WD
15 1J
13 1J
16 1J
2 1H
6 1B
7 8 11 5
BZR2 BECU
HAZ
LSR
18 1L
1 10 18 22 4 21
WIG
TRLY GND1
SIG
ACC
PWS
12 1A
15 1A
21 1L
13 1A
22 1L
7 1A
23 1L
6 1A
24 1L
6 1F
8 1B
14 1A
24
17
ACT-
GND2
HRLY
L1
1 1G
L2
11 1K
5 1A
UL1
14
SPD
16
19
20
15
Body ECU
1 1K
10 1L
13
11 1L
ILE
24 1E
12 1L
12 1J
ACT+
3
STPI
WMTR
9 1E
26 1J
3 1K
9 1L
8 1A
16 1F
5 1K
6 1L
9 1K
16 1A
18 1A
RDEF
12
BDR1
BZR
23
2
6
9
14 1F
1 1B
3 1B
10 1B
27
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
: Center J/B
Instrument Panel Brace RH (See Page 21)
Black
A A
A
B B B B B
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
3A
3B
A
A A
A A
B B B B B
A A
A
A
B
B
B
B
A
A
B
B
B B B B B B
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
Gray
3C
C C C
B B
G G G
F F
F
E
B B
A A A
A A A
B B
E E
D D D
D D D
E E
E
F
B B
C C C
F F
G G G
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
Black
3D
B B
B B
D D
D D
D D
A A
A A A
A A A
A A
D D
C C C
C C C
D D
D
D
B B
B B
D D
D D
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
Dark Gray
B B B
F F
B B
F
E
E
B B
E
D
D
A A A
D
C
3E
A
C C
A
A
C C C
B
B
D D D
E
B
B
B
B
B
E
E
F
F
F
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
3F
A A
B
A A
B
B
B
A A
B B
B
B
A A A
B
B B
A
A
A
A
A
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
A
A
A
A
B
B
B
B
(from Instrument Panel Wire)
28
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
29
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
[Center J/B Inner Circuit]
A 3A
E 3C
A 3A
E 3C
A 3A
E 3C
B 3A
D 3C
B 3A
D 3C
B 3A
D 3C
B 3A
B 3D
B 3A
B 3D
A 3B
B 3D
A 3B
B 3D
A 3B
A 3D
A 3B
A 3D
B 3B
A 3D
B 3B
A 3D
B 3B
A 3D
B 3B
D 3D
B 3B
D 3D
B 3B
D 3D
C 3C
D 3D
C 3C
D 3D
C 3C
D 3D
B 3C
D 3D
B 3C
D 3D
B 3C
C 3D
B 3C
C 3D
A 3C
C 3D
A 3C
B 3E
A 3C
B 3E
F 3C
B 3E
F 3C
B 3E
F 3C
B 3E
G 3C
B 3E
G 3C
B 3E
G 3C
A 3E
A 3E
A 3E
(Cont. Next Page)
30
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F
(Cont'd)
F 3E
F 3E
F 3E
E 3E
E 3E
E 3E
D 3E
D 3E
D 3E
C 3E
C 3E
C 3E
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
31
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[2UZ–FE]
G2
G1
A46
A13
H8
E1
H6
A45
A47
F7
A12
B14
A44
A43
F8
A9
A10
C2
F6
A2
H4
F5
H3
H2
H1
F2
A15
C3
A 1 A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
A 2 A/C Lock Sensor
A/C Magnetic Clutch
A 9 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A 10 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A 12 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A 13 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A 14 Airbag Sensor Front LH
A 15 Airbag Sensor Front RH
A 43 Air Injection Control Driver
A 44 Air Injection Control Driver
A 45 Air Pressure Sensor
A 46 Air Pump
A 47 Air Switching Valve
E2
E3
A1
C1
H9
C4
A14
H10
F1
E 1 Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
E 2 Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
E 3 Engine Hood Courtesy SW
F 1 Front Fog Light LH
F 2 Front Fog Light RH
F 5 Front Parking Light LH
Front Turn Signal Light LH
F 6 Front Parking Light RH
Front Turn Signal Light RH
F 7 Front Wiper Motor
F 8 Fuel Pump Resistor
G 1 Generator
G 2 Generator
B 14 Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
C
C
C
C
1
2
3
4
Camshaft Position Sensor
Camshaft Timing Oil Control Valve LH
Camshaft Timing Oil Control Valve RH
Crankshaft Position Sensor
H 1
H 2
H 3
H 4
H 6
H 8
H 9
H10
Headlight LH (High)
Headlight LH (Low)
Headlight RH (High)
Headlight RH (Low)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Horn (High)
Horn (Low)
32
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[2UZ–FE]
I8
V13
I16
K2
P1
V11
S2
T3
T4
I15
V1
I13
V2
N1
I7
S28
W3
M1
S29
I14
I5
T1
V3
I6
I3
N2
J3
V4
J2
I4
J1
V12
I11
I12
I1
I2
W2
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.3
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.4
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.5
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.6
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.7
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.8
Injector No.1
Injector No.2
Injector No.3
Injector No.4
Injector No.5
Injector No.6
Injector No.7
Injector No.8
J 1 Junction Connector
J 2 Junction Connector
J 3 Junction Connector
K 1 Knock Sensor (Bank 1)
K 2 Knock Sensor (Bank 2)
W1
I10
P3
S3
K1
T2
I9
O1
O 1 Oil Pressure SW
P 1 Park/Neutral Position SW
P 3 Pressure SW
S 2
S 3
S 28
S 29
Starter
Starter
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
T 1 Theft Deterrent Horn
T 2 Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
T 3 Transfer Shift Actuator
T 4 Turbine Speed Sensor
V 1
V 2
V 3
V 4
V 11
VSV (ACIS)
VSV (Purge)
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically Controlled Transmission)
V 12 VSV (Air Switching Valve Bank 1)
V 13 VSV (Air Switching Valve Bank 2)
M 1 Mass Air Flow Meter
N 1 Noise Filter (Ignition No.1)
N 2 Noise Filter (Ignition No.2)
W 1 Washer Level Sensor
W 2 Washer Motor
W 3 Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
33
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[1GR–FE]
H6
E1
H8
E2
A13
C4
F7
B14
F8
A12
G2
A10
G1
A11
A9
F6
F5
H4
H2
H3
H1
F2
A15
C3
E3
A 1 A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
A 2 A/C Lock Sensor
A/C Magnetic Clutch
A 9 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A 10 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A 11 ADD Actuator
A 12 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A 13 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A 14 Airbag Sensor Front LH
A 15 Airbag Sensor Front RH
A1
C2
H9
A2
H10
A14
F1
F 1 Front Fog Light LH
F 2 Front Fog Light RH
F 5 Front Parking Light LH
Front Turn Signal Light LH
F 6 Front Parking Light RH
Front Turn Signal Light RH
F 7 Front Wiper Motor
F 8 Fuel Pump Resistor
G 1 Generator
G 2 Generator
B 14 Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
C 2 Camshaft Timing Oil Control Valve LH
C 3 Camshaft Timing Oil Control Valve RH
C 4 Crankshaft Position Sensor
E 1 Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
E 2 Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
E 3 Engine Hood Courtesy SW
H 1
H 2
H 3
H 4
H 6
H 8
H 9
H10
Headlight LH (High)
Headlight LH (Low)
Headlight RH (High)
Headlight RH (Low)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Horn (High)
Horn (Low)
34
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[1GR–FE]
I13
P1
V11
N1
T3
V1
T4
I14
K1
I6
I12
I4
V2
S28
I5
W3
I3
S29
I11
S3
T1
S2
I1
I2
M1
J3
I9
J2
J1
K2
I10
W2
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
1
2
3
4
5
6
9
10
11
12
13
14
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.3
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.4
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.5
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.6
Injector No.1
Injector No.2
Injector No.3
Injector No.4
Injector No.5
Injector No.6
J 1 Junction Connector
J 2 Junction Connector
J 3 Junction Connector
K 1 Knock Sensor (Bank 1)
K 2 Knock Sensor (Bank 2)
M 1 Mass Air Flow Meter
N 1 Noise Filter (Ignition No.1)
O 1 Oil Pressure SW
W1
P2
P3
V4
T2
V3
O1
P 1 Park/Neutral Position SW
P 2 Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
P 3 Pressure SW
S 2
S 3
S 28
S 29
Starter
Starter
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
T 1 Theft Deterrent Horn
T 2 Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
T 3 Transfer Shift Actuator
T 4 Turbine Speed Sensor
V 1
V 2
V 3
V 4
V 11
VSV (ACIS)
VSV (Purge)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically Controlled Transmission)
W 1 Washer Level Sensor
W 2 Washer Motor
W 3 Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
35
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
(*4)
(*3)
A20
A21
A39
A27
A36
B1
A37
A29
(*4)
(*3)
A26
A28
A48
A49
* 1:w/ Side Airbag
* 2:w/o Side Airbag
* 3:Limited
* 4:Except Limited
A25
A18
A24
B2
A42
B3
A17
A16
B4
B5
B6
A19
A 16
A 17
A 18
A 19
A 20
A 21
A 22
A 24
A 25
A 26
A 27
A 28
A 29
A 30
A 31
A 32
A 33
A 34
A 36
A 37
A 38
A 39
A 42
A 48
A 49
A30
A31
(*1)
(*2)
A/C Control Assembly
A/C Control Assembly
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A/C Room Temp. Sensor
A/C Solar Sensor
A/C Solar Sensor
A/T Shift Lever Illumination
Accel Position Sensor
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
Air Mix Control Servo Motor LH
Air Mix Control Servo Motor RH
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
Antenna Amplifier
Ashtray Illumination
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Auto LSD SW
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
A32
A33
A34
(*1)
(*2)
B
B
B
B
B
B
1
2
3
4
5
6
A38
A22
Back Door Power Window Control SW
Blower Motor
Blower Motor Controller
Body ECU
Body ECU
Body ECU
36
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
D2
D24
C8
C9
C12
C10
C11
C13
C14
C5
D3
H11
G3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
F10
F9
D4
C 5
C 6
C 7
C 8
C 9
C10
C 11
C12
C13
C14
C15
D1
Center Speaker
Cigarette Lighter
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination SW
Combination SW
Combination SW
Cup Holder Illumination
D 1 Data Link Connector 3
D 2 Daytime Running Light Relay
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
D 3 Defogger SW
Heater Control Panel
Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
Security Indicator Light
D 4 Diff. Lock SW
D 5 Downhill Assist Control SW
D24 Diode (Rear Wiper)
I18
I17
F11
C7
C6
C15
E
E
E
E
E
4
5
6
7
8
D5
H12
H19
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
F 9 4WD Control ECU
F 10 4WD Control ECU
F 11 4WD Control SW
G 3 Glove Box Light
H 11 Hazard SW
H12 Height Control SW
H19 Height Control Mode Select SW
I 17 Ignition Key Cylinder Light
Transponder Key Amplifier
I 18 Ignition SW
37
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
J10
J20
J8
J9
J18
J16
J17
J19
J21
J52
J51
J50
J49
(*6)
(*5)
J26
J27
J28
J29
J30
J31
J32
J11
J33
J12
J34
J13
J35
J4
J36
J14
J48
J6
J47
J7
J37
J15
J25
J5
* 5:1GR-FE
* 6:2UZ-FE
J22
J 4
J 5
J 6
J 7
J 8
J 9
J 10
J 11
J 12
J 13
J 14
J 15
J 16
J 17
J 18
J 19
J 20
J 21
J 22
J 23
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
J23
J24
J 24
J 25
J 26
J 27
J 28
J 29
J 30
J 31
J 32
J 33
J 34
J 35
J 36
J 37
J 47
J 48
J 49
J 50
J 51
J 52
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
38
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
V5
R13
S30
(*7)
(*7)
(*9)
(*7) (*10) (*9)
(*7)
(*8)
(*8)
(*7)
(*7)
R27
R10
R2
R9
R11
R4
R5
R12
R26
R1
R3
* 7:w/ Navigation System
* 8:w/o Navigation System
* 9:6 Speaker
* 10:10 Speaker
w/o Navigation System
T8
T5
Z1
P4
T16
S13
V14
S14
S31
S15
T6
S12
M2
T9
K 3 Key Interlock Solenoid
Unlock Warning SW
M 2 Main SW
P 4 Parking Brake SW
P 5 Power Outlet (115V)
P 6 Power Outlet (Front)
R 1
R 2
R 3
R 4
R 5
R 9
R10
R 11
R12
R13
R25
R26
R27
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Radio and Player with Display
Radio and Player with Display
Radio and Player with Display
Radio and Player with Display
Rheostat
Roll Sensing of Curtain Shield Airbag Cutoff SW
Radio and Player with Display
Radio and Player with Display
R25
K3
S11
Y1
S6
P6
S4
S5
P5
S 4 Seat Heater SW LH
S 5 Seat Heater SW RH
S 6 Shift Lock Control ECU
Transmission Control SW
S 11 Steering Sensor
S 12 Stop Light SW
S 13 Suspension Control ECU
S 14 Suspension Control ECU
S 15 Suspension Control ECU
S 30 Seat Memory SW
S 31 Stereo Jack Adapter
T 5
T 6
T 8
T 9
T 16
Theft Deterrent ECU
Towing Brake Controller
Transponder Key Computer
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
V 5 VSC Warning Buzzer
V 14 Video Terminal
Y 1 Yaw Rate Sensor
Z 1 Option Connector (TVIP ECU)
39
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Body
(*2)
I19
D23
D18
D13
I20
D9
D19
C16
H18
(*1)
L2
H18
* 1:w/ Rear Spoiler
* 2:w/o Rear Spoiler
C17
D11
D16
D21
D17
D15
J38
J42
D8
D7
D22
H16
D12
B10
A41
B11
D10
D20
D14
J39
F14
H15
A 40 ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
A 41 ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
A40
H17
H13
L1
H14
J40
L4
B8
B9
D19 Door Lock Detection SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor Front RH
D20 Door Lock Detection SW Rear LH
Door Lock Motor Rear LH
D21 Door Lock Detection SW Rear RH
Door Lock Motor Rear RH
D22 Door Speaker Front LH No.1
D23 Door Speaker Front RH No.1
B 7 Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
Back Door Lock Detection SW
Back Door Lock Motor
B 8 Back Door ECU
B 9 Back Door ECU
B 10 Back Door Opener SW
License Plate Light
B 11 Back Door Power Window Motor
F 14 Fuel Pump
Fuel Sender
C16 Curtain Shield Airbag Squib LH
C17 Curtain Shield Airbag Squib RH
D 7
D 8
D 9
D10
D 11
D12
D13
D14
D15
D16
J41
Door Control Receiver
Door Courtesy Light Front LH
Door Courtesy Light Front RH
Door Courtesy Light Rear LH
Door Courtesy Light Rear RH
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Lock Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor Front LH
D17 Door Lock Control SW Front LH
Power Window Master SW
D18 Door Lock Control SW Front RH
H13
H14
H15
H16
H17
H18
Height Control Compressor
Height Control Motor
Height Control Sensor Rear LH
Height Control Sensor Rear RH
Height Control Valve
High Mounted Stop Light
I 19 Inner Mirror
I 20 Interior Light
J 38
J 39
J 40
J 41
J 42
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
L 1 Low Pressure Tank Valve
L 2 Luggage Compartment Light
L 4 Canister Pump Module
40
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B7
G
Position of Parts in Body
P17
V6
M4
P7
T18
M5
S21
V7
P13
R18
P9
T13
P11
P15
T17
S19
W4
S20
M3
R20
P12
S23
R24
S22
P10
P8
P14
R15
S32
R22
T12
R21
P16
T10
S16
T11
R16
S33
S34
S18
V9
M 3 Mirror Heater LH
Remote Control Mirror LH
M 4 Mirror Heater RH
Remote Control Mirror RH
M 5 Moon Roof Control ECU
P 7 Moon Roof Control SW
Personal Light
P 8 Power Outlet (Rear)
P 9 Power Window Control SW Front RH
P 10 Power Window Control SW Rear LH
P 11 Power Window Control SW Rear RH
P 12 Power Window Motor Front LH
P 13 Power Window Motor Front RH
P 14 Power Window Motor Rear LH
P 15 Power Window Motor Rear RH
P 16 Pretensioner LH
P 17 Pretensioner RH
R14
R15
R16
R17
R18
R19
R20
R21
R22
R23
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Door Speaker LH
Rear Door Speaker RH
Rear Seat Audio Controller
Rear Speaker LH
Rear Speaker RH
Rear Window Defogger
Rear Window Defogger
Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Position SW
R24 Remote Control Mirror SW
S17
T14
R17
R19
R14
S35
T15
R23
S 16
S 17
S 18
S 19
S 20
S 21
S 22
S 23
S 32
S 33
S 34
S 35
Side Airbag Sensor Front LH
Side Airbag Sensor Front RH
Side Airbag Sensor Rear LH
Side Airbag Sensor Rear RH
Door Speaker Front LH No.2
Door Speaker Front RH No.2
Stereo Component Amplifier
Stereo Component Amplifier
Step Light Front LH
Step Light Front RH
Step Light Rear LH
Step Light Rear RH
T 10
T 11
T 12
T 13
T 14
T 15
T 17
T 18
Tailgate Control SW
Television Camera
Tension Reducer Solenoid LH
Tension Reducer Solenoid RH
Towing Converter Relay
Trailer Socket
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
Telephone Microphone
V 6 Vanity Light LH
V 7 Vanity Light RH
V 9 Voltage Inverter
W 4 Woofer
41
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Seat
[Power Seat]
J53
P24
S24
P26
O3
J45
J46
O4
S27
P19
B15
P21
L5
O5
S25
O7
B17
B16
O6
* 1:w/ Driving Position Memory
* 2:w/o Driving Position Memory
J43
J44
(*2)
(*2)
B12
P20
S26
P28
P27
P18
(*1)
(*2)
L3
P23
P 18
P 19
P 20
P 21
P 23
P 24
P 25
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
L 3 Lumbar Support Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
L 5 Lumbar Support Control Motor (Driver’s Seat)
O
O
O
O
O
O
3
4
5
6
7
8
P25
Power Seat Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
Power Seat Control SW (Front Passenger’s Seat)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Front Vertical Control)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Lifter Control)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Reclining Control)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Slide Control)
Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger’s Seat Reclining Control)
P 26 Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger’s Seat Slide Control)
P 27 Position Control ECU and SW
P 28 Position Control ECU and SW
B 12 Buckle SW LH
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
B 15 Buckle SW LH
B 16 Buckle SW RH
B 17 Buckle SW RH
J 43
J 44
J 45
J 46
J 53
O8
Occupant Classification ECU
Occupant Classification ECU
Occupant Classification Sensor Front LH
Occupant Classification Sensor Front RH
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear LH
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear RH
S 24
S 25
S 26
S 27
Seat Heater LH
Seat Heater RH
Side Airbag Squib LH
Side Airbag Squib RH
42
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
Position of Parts in Seat
[Manual Seat]
B16
B17
J45
J46
S27
J43
J44
B12
S26
L3
B15
L5
O5
O3
O4
O6
O
O
O
O
O
O
B 12 Buckle SW LH
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
B 15 Buckle SW LH
B 16 Buckle SW RH
B 17 Buckle SW RH
J 43
J 44
J 45
J 46
O7
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
3
4
5
6
7
8
O8
Occupant Classification ECU
Occupant Classification ECU
Occupant Classification Sensor Front LH
Occupant Classification Sensor Front RH
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear LH
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear RH
S 26 Side Airbag Squib LH
S 27 Side Airbag Squib RH
L 3 Lumbar Support Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
L 5 Lumbar Support Control Motor (Driver’s Seat)
43
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[2UZ–FE]
Engine Wire
EB2
EB1
EE
EQ
ER
ED
EC
EB
EA
EA1
Engine Room Main Wire
Engine No.2 Wire
44
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[1GR–FE]
Engine Wire
EE
Sensor Wire
EF
ED1
EC1
EB
Differential Wire
EA
EA2
Engine Room Main Wire
Engine No.2 Wire
45
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Relay Wire
Instrument Panel
No.2 Wire
IG1
IH1
II1
Engine Wire
Engine Room
Main Wire
Roof Wire
Instrument Panel
Wire Assembly
Instrument
Panel Wire
Engine Room
Main Wire
IB2
IB1
IC1
Front Door
RH Wire
IC3
Cigarette Lighter
Wiring Assembly
IC4
Floor Wire
IA1
IA2
IV1
IC5
Front Door
LH Wire
Console Box
Wire (No.1)
ID1
IE1
Radio Installation
Wiring Sub Assembly
IC2
Floor No.2 Wire
IF1
: Location of Ground Points
II
IK
IG
IH
46
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
IJ
G
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Instrument Panel Instrument
No.2 Wire
Panel Wire
IJ1
Engine Wire Instrument Panel
Wire Assembly
Engine Room
Main Wire
IL1
IU1
IM1
IM2
Engine Room
Main Wire
IN2
IN1
Roof Wire
IP1
Radio
Installation
Wiring Sub
Assembly
Front Door
RH Wire
IP2
Front Door
LH Wire
IO3
Floor No.1
Wire
IT1
IO2
Floor No.2 Wire
Relay Wire
IK1
Cigarette Lighter
Wiring Assembly
IR1
IS1
Console Box
Wire
47
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
Roof Wire
Radio Installation
Wiring Sub Assembly
BJ1
Front Door
RH Wire
BD1
BD2
Instrument
Panel Wire
BB1
BM
Rear Door
No.1 Wire
Floor Wire
Back Door
No.1 Wire
Front Door
LH Wire
BA1
BP
BL
BL1
Step Rear
Floor RH
Wire
BO
Step Rear
Floor LH Wire
Back Door
No.2 Wire
BE1
Rear Door
No.2 Wire
BH1
Floor No.2
Wire
BG1
BC1
BC2
BM1
BN
Skid Control
Frame Wire Sensor Wire
BF1
48
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Frame No.3
Wire
Memo
49
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
[Power Seat]
Floor Wire
BI1
* 1:w/ Driving Position Memory
Floor No.2 Wire
BK1
(*1)
Seat No.2 Wire
50
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Seat No.1 Wire
G
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
[Manual Seat]
Floor Wire
BI1
Floor No.2 Wire
Seat No.2 Wire
Seat No.1 Wire
51
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Source
10A MIR HEATER
B–R
1
2
2
B–L
2
30A DEFOG
1
2
Y–G
2
DEFOG Relay
B–R
W–B
2
2
2
1
3
5
R
2
2
L–Y
Y–R
4
2
50A AIR SUS
30A TOWING BRK
B
2
2
2
2
2
2
BR–Y
4
5
3
1
2
4
4
1
1
1
1
2
2
W–L
2
2
1
1C
L–W
10A SECU/HORN
30A P P/SEAT
2
2
L
30A D P/SEAT
10A STOP
1
1
2
2
G–W
1
2
2
5
3
1
2
10A TAIL
V
15A FR FOG
1
2
30A POWER
15A AC115V INV
TAIL Relay
2
2
LG
15A PWR OUTLET
140A ALT
7. 5A OBD
2
1
2
2
O
B
2
25A SEAT HEATER
IG Relay
5
3
1
2
2
2
2
B–Y
2
1
W–B
Y–R
Battery
B
2
W–B
50A J/B
1
2
L–B
50A AM1
40A TOWING
1
GR
AIR SUS Relay
50A A/PUMP
R
4
1
2
30A BATT CHG
B–Y
L–Y
2
2
10A AIRSUS NO. 2
2
1
1
54
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
2
LG
Y–R
R
2
2
HEATER Relay
1
2
5
3
L
2
7. 5A HEATER NO. 2
B–Y
2
4
1
2
2
2
G–Y
W–B
2
I18
Ignition SW
W–L
ACC 3
W–G
W–L
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
R
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
ST2 8
G–B
30A AM2
2
1
2
40A ABS MTR
2
1
60A HEATER
R
2
Y–B
30A ABS SOL
1
2
2
2
1
2
Y
Short Pin
1
2
2
W
W
L
L
20A EFI
1
2
1
1
10A HORN
W–G
2
2
1
2
2
1
15A TRN–HAZ
B–Y
2
2
2
GR
20A DR/LCK
1
15A A/F HEATER
B–R
2
10A HEAD(HI RH)
2
2
G–W
1
GR
1
30A TOWING
1
2
20A RADIO NO. 2
1
1
2
2
R–W
10A HEAD(HI LH)
2
2
2
R–B
2
2
10A ETCS
7. 5A ALT–S
W
2
2
2
2
R–L
10A HEAD(LO RH)
W–L
1
2
2
R–B
10A HEAD(LO LH)
HEAD Relay
5
3
1
2
R–B
2
2
2
1
2
2
R–Y
W
55
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Source
7. 5A ACC
W–G
5
1D
10A CIG
15A IG1
10A ECU–IG
15A RR WSH
20A 4WD
W–G
2
1C
L–Y
30A FR WIP–WSH
10A IGN
6
1D
B–R
7. 5A GAUGE
10A SRS
G–B
3
1D
7. 5A STA NO. 2
10A DOME
1
2
R
2
20A RADIO NO. 1
W
1
2
2
L–Y
2
10A ECU–B
L
1
2
W–R
2
EFI Relay
W–G
L
2
2
1
5
2
3
2
2
W–B
10A EFI NO. 2
B
2
56
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
2
2
L–W
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
I18
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
37
: Relay Blocks
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
2
22
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
4
23
Engine Room R/B No.4 (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1C
1D
See Page
24
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
57
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Starting
∗
∗
∗
∗
7 AM2
1
2
3
4
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE
: 1GR–FE Cold Area Spec.
: 1GR–FE Except Cold Area Spec.
IG2
G–B
G–B
ST2 8
I18
Ignition SW
R
3 1D
7. 5A
STA
NO. 2
B–Y
G
G
B–Y
A A (∗1)
B B (∗2)
A A
B B
2
2
2
L–Y
J35
Junction
Connector
3
G
J27(B), J28(A)
Junction
Connector
1
11 IM1
B–Y
2 IC4
STA Relay
5
Combination Meter
B–Y
2
B–Y
2
5
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
1
6 EA1 (∗1)
4 EA2 (∗2)
B–Y
L–Y
(∗2)
Y
B
8 B
11 C
12 C
B
(∗1)
6 IM2 (∗1)
4 IM2 (∗2)
4
B
Y–G
N
J3
Junction
Connector
2
P
P
Y–G
W–B
B–Y
2
30A
AM2
A A (∗1)
B B (∗2)
B–Y
R
2
2 1K
B–Y
R
B–Y
R
1 C
B–L
W
(∗4)
M
(∗2)
(∗1)
(∗1)
1 1
A B
W–B
(∗3)
B–R
S 2(A), (B), S 3(C)
Starter
STAR/
NSW
STA
Battery
E 5(B), E 6(C)
Engine Control Module
EB
58
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
STSW
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
E5
B
37
J27
B
38
E6
C
37
J28
A
38
I18
37
J35
33 (2UZ–FE)
J3
P1
35 (1GR–FE)
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
Code
S2
S3
See Page
A
35 (1GR–FE)
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
C
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1D
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1K
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
EA2
45 (1GR–FE)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IM1
IM2
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
: Ground Points
Code
EB
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
59
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
H SYSTEM CIRCUITS
2007 4RUNNER
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
SYSTEM CIRCUITS
ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Active Height Control Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audio System (w/ Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audio System (10 Speaker) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audio System (6 Speaker) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Auto LSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic Glare–Resistant EC Mirror with Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic Light Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Back–Up Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Combination Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Door Lock Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Downhill Assist Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electric Modulated Air Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electric Tension Reducer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE) . . . .
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE) . . . . .
Engine Control (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Control (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Immobiliser System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Fog Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Wiper and Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Garage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hill–Start Assist Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ignition (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ignition (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interior Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Key Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Light Auto Turn Off System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mirror Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Moon Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multi Mode 4WD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multiplex Communication System (CAN Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Outlet (115V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Outlet (12V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/ Driving Position Memory) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
52
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Page
258
268
358
334
342
348
258
302
140
174
68
296
352
252
246
202
258
268
306
238
230
84
70
98
136
184
182
130
258
304
64
60
162
154
176
142
330
288
274
104
100
102
334
334
300
298
308
H
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/o Driving Position Memory) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Seat (Front Passenger’s Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Window Defogger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Wiper and Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat Belt Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shift Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Taillight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Theft Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Warning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (w/ Daytime Running Light) . . . . .
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (w/o Daytime Running Light) . . . .
VSC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wireless Door Lock Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
312
316
54
192
330
186
294
178
318
292
281
58
170
162
222
326
258
322
146
150
258
212
53
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Ignition for 2UZ–FE
7 AM2
B–R
IG2 6
ST2
I18
Ignition SW
B–Y
R
7 EA1
1 EB1
B–R
W–B
B–R
4
1
3
2
L–W
R–W
4
1
4
3
2
I4
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
I3
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
2
I2
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
I1
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
R
2
R–Y
2
B–R
3
3
LG
1
W–B
W–B
R–Y
W–B
B–R
W–B
L–Y
B–R
4
1
B–R
W–B
B–R
R–W
B–R
B–R
B–R
LG–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
2
30A
AM2
R–Y
R–Y
R–Y
R–Y
R–W
R–W
R–W
1
LG
R–Y
LG–B
R–W
L–W
L–Y
B
2
8
24
15
25
11
10
IGT1
IGF1
IGT2
IGF2
IGT3
Battery
E4
Engine Control Module
60
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
IGT4
G
G–W
IGT5
1
4
1
4
1
4
R–W
R–W
R–W
IGT6
2
3
2
13
12
14
IGT7
ED
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
N1
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 1)
W–B
4
B–R
B–R
W–B
B–R
1
W–B
R–Y
N2
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 2)
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–Y
I8
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 8
B–R
B–R
W–B
R–Y
3
R–W
2
G–B
3
R–Y
W–B
W–B
G–W
B–R
W–B
I7
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 7
I6
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
W–B
B–R
R–Y
2
R–W
B–R
B–R
G
3
B–L
B–R
G–B
B–L
I5
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
B–R
B–R
B–R
W–B
1
E4
Engine Control Module
ER
2
1
IGT8
9
B
EC
61
Ignition for 2UZ–FE
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
E4
37
I4
33 (2UZ–FE)
I8
33 (2UZ–FE)
I1
33 (2UZ–FE)
I5
33 (2UZ–FE)
I18
37
I2
33 (2UZ–FE)
I6
33 (2UZ–FE)
N1
33 (2UZ–FE)
I3
33 (2UZ–FE)
I7
33 (2UZ–FE)
N2
33 (2UZ–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
EB1
44 (2UZ–FE)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Wire (Near the Starter)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EC
44 (2UZ–FE)
Right Bank Cylinder Head
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
ER
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Front Right Fender
62
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
63
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Headlight
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
(BAT)
(ACC)
10A
ECU–B
(IG)
7. 5A
ACC
10A
ECU–IG
SIG
10
ACC
22
BECU
HRLY
11
17
HF2
20 C
2
R–B
2
R–B
4 1B
8 1B
W
W
W–R
19 IC4
2
2
R–B
R–B
W
W
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 3 : 1GR–FE
2
3
HEAD
Relay
1
5
B
2
Battery
130
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
R–B
R–B
R–B
2
1
10A
HEAD
(LO LH)
2
10A
HEAD
(LO RH)
10A
HEAD
(HI LH)
2
10A
HEAD
(HI RH)
2
2
23 IC4
1
1
R–G
W–B
W–B
1
R–W
2
H1
Headlight LH
(High)
2
H4
Headlight RH
(Low)
R–W
2
R–L
2
R–B
2
2
R–Y
2
2
1
12 D
10 IN1
R–G
7 IM1
R–G
Beam
13 D
C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
Head (USA)
13 C
BR
R–G
22 IC4
R–G
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B(∗1)
(∗1)
W–B
W–B(∗1)
EA
EB
ED
(∗3)
BR
BR
(∗2)
W–B
(∗1)
W–B
H2
Headlight LH
(Low)
1
R–W
1
R–G
1
H3
Headlight RH
(High)
2
EE
131
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Headlight
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
HEAD
GND1
HF
7 C
R–W
1 IH1
9 IH1
GND2
4
PKB
2 B
16
L
14 A
2 1H
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
LG
GR
R
1 C
E B
GR
8
W–B
A
Head
W–B
1 EA1 (∗2)
3 EA2 (∗3)
High
Flash
LH
RH
L
(∗1)
G–Y
3
(∗1)
1
G–B
4
7
R–G
Turn
GR
Dimmer SW
Auto
Low
6 IC4
1
GR
A
P4
Parking Brake SW
J15
Junction
Connector
Tail
LG
2
OFF
Light
Control SW
1 1E
W–B
16
(∗1)
R–W
13
A A
W–B
W–B
C12
Combination SW
R
17 1J
E A
E A
E A
R–G
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
R–G
D B
R–G
G2
Generator
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction Connector
B A
R–G
G–Y(∗1)
B B
G–B(∗1)
R–G
R–G
W–B(∗1)
W–B(∗1)
W–B(∗1)
W–B(∗1)
A
A
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 3 : 1GR–FE
IG
132
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J5
Junction
Connector
W–B
A
W–B
(∗1)
(∗1)
W–B
(∗1)
J37
Junction
Connector
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
TFR
8
7
4
2
(∗1)
W–B
20 IC4
H11
Hazard SW
A
1 IN1
3
2
B 3F
B 3F
A
IK
(∗1)
TFL
W–B
TSL
(∗1)
TSR
W–B
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
14 1J
J24
Junction
Connector
2
R–Y
(∗1)
R–B
12
(∗1)
42 IC4
R–Y
(∗1)
R–B
(∗1)
G–B
DRL
(∗1)
3
F6
Front Turn Signal
Light RH
2 IH1
(∗1)
(∗1)
LG–R
7 A
W–B
E A
3 IH1
F5
Front Turn Signal
Light LH
D B
G–B
9
(∗1)
E
G–Y
IG
(∗1)
DRL
G–Y
1
(∗1)
B 3F
B
(∗1)
H A
W–B
6
(∗1)
(∗1)
B–Y
2
W–B
F B
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
J7
Junction
Connector
(∗1)
B–Y
8 1J
(∗1)
Y–R
15A
IG1
(∗1)
Y–R
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
D2
Daytime Running
Light Relay
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
(∗1)
Y–R
(IG)
W–B
G–Y(∗1)
(∗1)
Y–R
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
8
HAZ
(BAT)
15A
TRN–HAZ
15 1J
2
2
A
3
10
HAZ
G–B(∗1)
W–B(∗1)
W–B(∗1)
A
II
133
Headlight
System Outline
(w/ daytime running light)
∗ This system is designed to automatically activate the turn signal lights during the daytime to keep the car highly visible to
other vehicles. This system is controlled by the body ECU.
This system makes use of the turn signal lights as daytime running lights.
For this reason, when the turn signal lights are operated, the daytime running lights function is interrupted momentarily,
which, however, will be brought back into operation as soon as the interposed operation is over.
∗ This system is enabled when the conditions given below are met.
A) Ignition switch ON condition
B) Turn signal light switch OFF condition
C) Hazard light switch OFF condition
D) Light control switch OFF condition
E) Parking brake switch OFF condition (Parking brake out of operating condition)**
**: This system does not become active when the parking brake switch is ON. However, once the OFF signal of the
parking brake switch is input into the body ECU, this system will become active thereafter, regardless of whether the
parking brake switch is ON or OFF.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B4
A
36
B5
B
36
B6
C
36
C10
C
37
C11
D
37
C12
37
D2
37
Code
H1
F6
G2
Code
J12
34 (1GR–FE)
J13
32 (2UZ–FE)
H2
H3
H4
32 (2UZ–FE)
F5
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
See Page
A
38
B
38
J15
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J18
A
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J19
B
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J20
A
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J21
B
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J22
A
38
J23
B
38
34 (1GR–FE)
H11
37
32 (2UZ–FE)
J5
38
J24
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J7
38
J37
38
P4
39
32 (2UZ–FE)
J10
A
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J11
B
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1E
1H
1J
3F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EA2
45 (1GR–FE)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
134
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
EE
135
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Front Fog Light
R
R–B
R
R–L
2
G–R
1
B 6(C)
Body ECU
1 C
HEAD
G–R
R
HF2
HRLY
17
10A
HEAD
(HI LH)
2 IC3
1 IH1
2
20 C
W–B
G–R
R
W–B
R–L
2
10
13
16
8 1B
C12
Combination SW
Light
Control SW
W
W
OFF
19 IC4
Tail
Head
R–B
W
Fog
Light
SW
W
Dimmer SW
Auto
2
2
2
3
1
5
Low
High
Flash
OFF
ON
11
17
HEAD
Relay
R–G
B
2
Battery
136
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(BAT)
15A
FR FOG
2
R–L
LG
R–L
2
G–R
2
2
2
5
FR FOG
Relay
W–B
1
3
2
2
G
G–R
G
W–B
G
1
A
G
F2
Front Fog Light RH
G
1
2
10 D
C10(C), C11(D)
Combination
Meter
Front Fog
2
13 C
BR
W–B
W–B
A
7 IM1
BR
(1GR–FE)
(2UZ–FE)
A
BR
W–B
W–B
J15
Junction
Connector
F1
Front Fog Light LH
G
12 IC3
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
EA
ED
EE
137
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Front Fog Light
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B6
C
36
C10
C
37
C11
D
37
C12
Code
F1
F2
37
See Page
Code
J5
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J15
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
34 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
See Page
24
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IC3
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IC4
: Ground Points
Code
EA
ED
EE
IG
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
46
Left Kick Panel
138
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
139
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Automatic Light Control
(BAT)
(BAT)
50A
J/B
(IG)
10A
ECU–B
2
(ACC)
7. 5A
ACC
10A
ECU–IG
2
2
L–W
W–R
2
1 1C
4 1B
5
1
TAIL
Relay
3
2
18
11
TRLY
BECU
GND1
HRLY
4
GND2
16
22
ACC
SIG
A
3 C
B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
CLTB
6 C
CLTE
21 C
CLTS
4 C
G–W
Y
3 IG1
2 IG1
1 IG1
G–W
Y
G–O
10 IH1
L–Y
2 1H
8 1B
L–Y
G–O
17
10
W
C12
Combination SW
12
R–B
Light
Control SW
OFF
16
HEAD
Relay
1
3
4
CLTB
CLTE
CLTS
5
A
2
J15
Junction
Connector
1
Head
Auto
3
W–B
2
2
W–B
2
Tail
W–B
B
A
Battery
A
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
140
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A39
Automatic Light Control
Sensor
System Outline
The automatic light control system works when the light control SW is turned to AUTO. The automatic light control sensor
detects the brightness around the vehicle. By this function, the system automatically turns the taillight and headlight on if the
brightness is below the regular level and turns the taillight and headlight off when the surroundings become brighter than the
regular level.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A39
Code
See Page
36
C12
37
Code
See Page
J15
38
B5
B
36
D12
40
J18
A
38
B6
C
36
J5
38
J19
B
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1C
1H
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IG1
46
Instrument Panel No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
: Ground Points
Code
IG
See Page
46
Ground Points Location
Left Kick Panel
141
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Light Auto Turn Off System
(BAT)
(ACC)
7. 5A
ACC
50A
J/B
2
L–W
2
1 1C
5
1
TAIL
Relay
2
18
ACC
G–O
1 IH1
8 IH1
10 IH1
R–B
G–O
H B
14
12
W
13
F A
6 IO3
A
2
W–B
B
A
Battery
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
142
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
1
P–L
P–B
1
D14
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
W–B
1
5
A
RRCY
12 B
37 IE1
D13
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
16
J15
Junction
Connector
1
Head
C12
Combination SW
HEAD
Relay
RLCY
11 B
Tail
Auto
3
W–B
2
2
PCTY
24 B
R–B
R–B
Light
Control SW
OFF
2
DCTY
23 B
P–L
A
3 C
G
2 1H
8 1B
TAIL
8 C
P–B
HEAD
1 C
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
R–Y
GND2
16
G
4
R
GND1
HRLY
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
TRLY
17
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
22
R
3
(IG)
(BAT)
(BAT)
10A
ECU–B
10A
ECU–IG
10A
DOME
2
2
2
R
2
W–R
8 1F
4 1B
12 1F
10 IC4
R
B–R
W–R
D
J7
Junction
Connector
D
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
11
R
10
BECU
MPX2
23 A
BR–R
F
J39
Junction
Connector
3
5
PRG
+B
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
W–R
2
RDA
E
40 IE1
BR–R
R
41 IE1
G–O
39 IE1
L–R
F
38 IE1
E
B–R
G–O
PRG
3 B
L–R
RDA
4 B
R
SIG
E
D7
Door Control
Receiver
5
9 BD1
10
BD1
7 BD1
6
3
5 BD1
B
R–G
G–Y
B–R
A B
L–R
A A
R
A A
W–B
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
W–B
1
3 A
1 A
5 A
6 A
6 B
7 B
21 B
MPX2
BECU
SIG
HALF
FULL
LSE
W–B
GND
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
BO
BL
143
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Light Auto Turn Off System
System Outline
When all doors are closed after opening some or all of them after the Ignition SW is turned from ON to OFF with the head
and tail lamps ON, these lamps will remain ON for 30 seconds after the doors are closed and then go OUT automatically.
Pressing the lock SW on a wireless controller twice in succession turns OFF the lamps instantly.
: Parts Location
Code
B4
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A
36
D7
40
B5
B
36
D12
40
J18
A
38
B6
C
36
D13
40
J19
B
38
40
D14
40
B7
J15
38
J39
40
B8
A
40
D15
40
J40
A
40
B9
B
40
J5
38
J41
B
40
37
J7
38
C12
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1C
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
144
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
145
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light with DRL
(IG)
(BAT)
15A
IG1
15A
TRN–HAZ
2
8 1J
A
B–Y
Y–R
2
J7
Junction
Connector
A
Y–R
20 IC4
H A
L–Y
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
L–B
5 1J
TRR
L–B
3
TRL
L–Y
5
L–B
B
L–Y
6
IG
L–Y
B–Y
1
L–B
Y–R
F B
23 1J
15 1F
9 1F
3 1G
2 1G
D2
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
14 1J
L–B
3 IH1
L–Y
2 IH1
HAZ
10
W
TSR
8
G–Y
1 IN1
TSL
7
G–B
42 IC4
E
9
W–B
R–Y
TFR
2
R–B
TFL
4
6
10
LH
2
C12
Combination SW
3
2
BR
W–B
13
D B
B 3F
W–B
A
W–B
Turn LH
Turn
Turn RH
H11
Hazard SW
RH
2
C10
Combination Meter
G–Y
3
W
G–B
R–Y
1
W–B
2
3
W–B
3
F6
Front Turn Signal
Light RH
F5
Front Turn Signal
Light LH
R–B
15 1J
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
B
3F
J15
Junction
Connector
E A
7 IM1
A
EB
A
EA
IG
A
W–B
J37
Junction
Connector
A
IK
146
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
ED
BR(1GR–FE)
W–B
J5
Junction
Connector
W–B
A
BR(2UZ–FE)
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
B 3F
EE
W–B
W–B
2
6
BL
3
A A
A A
L–Y
A
L–B
L–Y
L–B
L–B
L–Y
D
T14
Towing Converter
Relay
Turn
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
Turn
J39
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
W–B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
L–Y
L–B
D
A
D
9
3
LTIN
RTIN
6
A A
A B
BO
147
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light with DRL
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
C10
37
C12
D2
F5
F6
H11
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J5
38
J37
38
37
J7
38
37
J15
38
J40
A
40
J41
B
40
J39
40
32 (2UZ–FE)
J20
A
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J21
B
38
R14
41
32 (2UZ–FE)
J22
A
38
R15
41
34 (1GR–FE)
J23
B
38
T14
41
37
J24
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1F
1G
1J
3F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
EE
148
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
149
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light without DRL
(IG)
(BAT)
15A
IG1
15A
TRN–HAZ
2
A
L–Y
L–Y
L–B
L–B
L–Y
B–Y
A
B–Y
H A
3
IF1
5
L–Y
IF1
EL
L–Y
L–B
15 1F
9 1F
8
IF1
3 1G
2 1G
14 1J
L–B
IF1
G–B
7
23 1J
6
G–B
W–B
IF1
5 1J
ER
5
7
8
EHW
G–Y
T9
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
GND
LL
L–B
3
LR
L–Y
2
+B
W
4
W
L–B
1
IG
9
10 IF1
IF1
L–Y
6
B–Y
F B
IF1
Y–R
Y–R
L–B
1
6
10
G–Y
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
20 IC4
L–Y
J7
Junction
Connector
Y–R
2
L–B
8 1J
LH
13
3
C12
Combination SW
BR
W–B
2
W–B
D B
Turn LH
RH
Turn
H11
Hazard SW
2
Turn RH
3
C10
Combination Meter
G–Y
1
W
3 IH1
W–B
2 IH1
G–B
15 1J
B 3F
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
A
B
3F
J15
Junction
Connector
E A
7 IM1
A
IG
A
W–B
J37
Junction
Connector
A
IK
150
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
ED
BR(1GR–FE)
A
J5
Junction
Connector
W–B
A
BR(2UZ–FE)
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
B 3F
EE
W–B
2
6
BL
3
A A
A A
9
3
LTIN
RTIN
BO
3
2
EB
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R–Y
L–Y
R–Y
D
R–B
L–B
4
F6
Front Turn Signal
Light RH
R–B
A
F5
Front Turn Signal
Light LH
6
L–Y
A
L–B
L–Y
L–B
D
T14
Towing Converter
Relay
Turn
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
Turn
L–Y
W–B
W–B
W–B
J39
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
W–B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
L–Y
L–B
IF1
2
IF1
L–B
42 IC4
1 IN1
D
3
2
A A
A B
W–B
EA
151
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light without DRL
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
C10
37
C12
37
F5
F6
Code
See Page
J7
Code
38
J15
See Page
J39
40
38
J40
A
40
32 (2UZ–FE)
J20
A
38
J41
B
40
34 (1GR–FE)
J21
B
38
R14
41
32 (2UZ–FE)
J22
A
38
R15
41
34 (1GR–FE)
J23
B
38
T9
39
T14
41
H11
37
J24
38
J5
38
J37
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1F
1G
1J
3F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Relay Wire (Behind the Instrument Panel J/B)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
EE
152
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
153
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Interior Light
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
(ACC)
7. 5A
ACC
GND2
ACC
4
13
7 1A
8 1A
12 1A
18 1A
W
(∗1)
W–B
W
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
W–B
2 1H
ILE
GND1
16
22
W
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
1
W(∗4)
3
2 A (∗3)
2 B (∗4)
1
2
B
5
V6
Vanity Light LH
P7
Personal Light
W(∗4)
3 A
3 B
1
E
V7
Vanity Light RH
W
(∗3)
W(∗4)
W
(∗3)
W(∗4)
W
(∗1)
2
2
W
(∗1)
DOOR
(∗1)
R
1 A (∗3)
1 B (∗4)
ON
OFF
L2
Luggage Compartment
Light
DOOR
ON
OFF
I20(A), (B)
Interior Light
W
4 1A
19 1A
9 1A
6 1E
1
22 1J
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
W
W(∗4)
W
(∗3)
W(∗4)
R
R–W
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
154
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R
H
H
H
E
∗
∗
∗
∗
1
2
3
4
2
2
J35
Junction Connector
9 BB1
(∗2)
(∗2)
2
1
(∗2)
S35
Step Light Rear RH
W–R
2 BM1
4 IO3
R(∗2)
E
R–W
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
1
1
H
2 BL1
R
3 IE1
R
1
13 IA1
9 BA1
R
4 IE1
P–G
(∗2)
W–R
26 A
DCYL
1
2
D10
Door Courtesy Light
Rear LH
P–G
(∗2)
W–R
C A
W–G
8 BB1
D8
Door Courtesy Light
Front LH
Y–G
(∗2)
(∗2)
W–R
LP
R
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
6 B
R
E
(∗2)
(∗2)
2
R
5 IO3
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗2)
W–R
C A
S34
Step Light Rear LH
W–R
R
(∗2)
1 BL1
(∗2)
1 BM1
W–R
C B
S32
Step Light Front LH
W–R
R
R
R
(∗2)
S33
Step Light Front RH
W–R
R
L–R
Y
RCYL
R
A A
22 B
(∗2)
2
(∗2)
1
D11
Door Courtesy Light
Rear RH
L–R
9 IP1
R
C B
R
1
1 IP2
R
2
R
9 1K
R
R–G
PCYL
(∗2)
R
A A
I17
Ignition Key
Cylinder Light
6
D9
Door Courtesy Light
Front RH
Y
R
25 A
(∗2)
R
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
21 B
LCYL
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
9 IA1
8 BA1
1
2
E
E
J6
Junction Connector
: w/ Vanity Light
: Limited
: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
R–W
155
Interior Light
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
PRG
LMRY
3 B
DCTY
23 B
PCTY
24 B
R–B
R
41 IE1
10 IC4
1 IC3
R
39 IE1
D
R
R
38 IE1
J7
Junction Connector
R
G–O
D
L–R
D
R
3 A
R–Y
RDA
4 B
3
5
PRG
+B
10A
DOME
2
H B
2
R
E
1
D7
Door Control
Receiver
R
F A
2
W–B
2
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
R
2
RDA
L–R
G–O
(BAT)
DOME
Relay
1
3
1
2
R
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–W
2
1
D13
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
A B
A A
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
2
R–B
5
R
W–B
BO
W–B
W–B
R–W
BL
156
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
RLCY
11 B
RRCY
DRLP
12 B
12 C
DCY2
SIG
11 C
10
W–L
V–Y
(IG)
P–L
P–B
(IG)
10A
ECU–IG
7. 5A
GAUGE
17 A
8 C
4 1G
16 C
13 C
BR
R–L
R
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
D14
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
P–L
P–B
15 C
1
B–R
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
6 IO3
F B
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
37 IE1
Door
R–L
8 1F
(1GR–FE)
BR
BR
(2UZ–FE)
R
7 IM1
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
ED
EE
157
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Interior Light
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
MPX2
23 A
BECU
1 A
5 A
SIG
6 A
GND
3 A
FULL
LSE
7 B
21 B
B–R
MPX2
BECU
11
G–Y
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
6
3
B
W–B
40 IE1
9 BD1
7 BD1
5 BD1
10 BD1
W–R
B–R
W–B
W–R
2
W–R
2
L–R
12 1F
R
4 1B
10A
ECU–B
BR–R
(BAT)
BR–R
F
E
F
J39
Junction
Connector
E
B–R
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
B–R
W–B
158
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
System Outline
The interior light is controlled by the body ECU. This system has following features.
1. Normal Operation
∗ When one of the doors opened, the interior light, luggage compartment light and open door warning light is turned on.
When the all doors are closed, the interior light, luggage compartment light and open door warning light is turned off.
2. Illuminated Entry System
∗ When a door is unlocked through a key operation or transmitter operation, or if a door is opened or closed, the illuminated
entry system turns ON the interior light and the ignition key illumination.
∗ If the ignition switch is turned to the ACC or ON position or if all doors are locked during the 15 seconds in which these
lights are ON, they will immediately turn OFF.
: Parts Location
Code
B4
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
A
36
D14
40
B5
B
36
D15
40
J35
B6
C
36
I17
37
J39
B7
40
B8
A
40
I20
J21
See Page
B
38
38
40
A
40
J40
A
40
B
40
J41
B
40
B9
B
40
J5
38
L2
40
C8
A
37
J6
38
P7
41
C10
C
37
J7
38
S32
41
D7
40
J8
A
38
S33
41
D8
40
J9
B
38
S34
41
D9
40
J12
A
38
S35
41
D10
40
J13
B
38
V6
41
V7
41
D11
40
J18
A
38
D12
40
J19
B
38
D13
40
J20
A
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1A
1B
1E
1F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1H
1J
1K
159
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Interior Light
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA1
IC3
IC4
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BL1
48
Floor No.2 Wire and Step Rear Floor LH Wire (Near the Side Step LH)
BM1
48
Floor Wire and Step Rear Floor RH Wire (Near the Side Step RH)
IP1
IP2
: Ground Points
Code
ED
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
EE
160
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
161
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
IG
A B
8 C
TAIL
8 IH1
OFF
14
1
Tail
Head
A B
A A
2
EB
1
2
A
J5
Junction
Connector
EA
162
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
9 1B
G
TRLY
Stop/Tail
13 1F
W–B
2
Stop Light SW
STOP LP CTRL Relay
G
5 1L
G–Y
G
L–W
L–W
G
1 1C
F6
Front Parking Light RH
18
G
3
10A TAIL
2
W–B
1
5
F5
Front Parking Light LH
140A
ALT
G
TAIL Relay
50A
J/B
1
W–B
G
1
C12
Combination SW
G
B
2
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
Light
Control SW
2
W–B
W–B
Battery
B
Taillight and Illumination
G
G
2
B 6(C)
Body ECU
11 1B
2
1
4
6
16
W–B
W–B
G
G
G
J39
Junction Connector
G
∗ 1 : w/ Navigation System
∗ 2 : w/o Navigation System
B
B
B
G
B
G
G
B A
B A
B B
B B
B B
B B
G
G
G
1
1
1
1
G
G
Stop Light SW
STOP LP CTRL Relay
2 BD1
B B
J16(A), J17(B)
Junction Connector
G
B A
G
G
2
2
C13
Combination SW
2
A42
Auto LSD SW
RH
LH
1
3
3 BH1
W–R
W–G
W–G
W–B
W–G
10
W–B
6
2
W–B
Stop/Tail
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
B10
License Plate Light
4
M2
Main SW
4
W–G
1
D4
Diff. Lock SW
R25
Roll Sensing of
Curtain Shield Airbag Cutoff SW
G
G
G–Y
2 BH1
10 BD1
W–B
II1
W–B
1
A A
A A
A B
A B
W–B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
A A
A B
A A
A B
J16(A), J17(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
A A
A B
A A
W–R(∗1)
W–R(∗2)
W–G
W–G
W–B
W–B
BL
BO
163
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Taillight and Illumination
G
G
G
G
G
G
D 3D
D 3D
D
3D
D 3D
D 3D
D 3D
G
D 3D
C15
Cup Holder Illumination
G
G
G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
W–G
W–G
W–G
(∗2)
2
A 3F
C 3E
(∗2)
2
1
A 3F
A 3F
W–R
2
1
10
C 3E
(∗1)
1
1
D5
Downhill Assist Control SW
G
ILL–
2
H19
Height Control Mode Select SW
ILL+
H12
Height Control SW
9
W–G
D3
Defogger SW
Heater Control Panel
ILL–
12 A (∗5)
5 C (∗6)
G
(∗2)
G
W–G
SWG
6 D
6 D
W–G
ILL–
12 B
R 1(A), R 2(B), R 3(C), R 5(D)
Radio and Player
G
(∗1)
SWG
6 A
2 A (∗5)
10 B (∗6)
ILL+ (∗7)
ILL+B(∗8)
W–G
13 D (∗3)
12 D (∗4)
ILL+
(∗1)
G
I B
2 B
W–R
D A
R10(A), R12(B)
Radio and Player
with Display
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
G
G
D 3D
G
ELS1(∗3)
ELS2(∗4)
W–G
E 7(D)
Engine Control
Module
W–R(∗1)
W–G
W–R(∗2)
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–B
W–B
W–G
164
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
G
G
G
G
1 IR1
3 IR1
W–G
2
2 IR1
4 IR1
F11
4WD Control SW
C7
Cigarette Lighter
Illumination
A38
Ashtray Illumination
2
3
W–G
1
W–B
4
1
W–G
5
1
W–B
5
W–G
5
1
G
G
G
G
G
G
A22
A/T Shift Lever Illumination
2
W–G
2
: w/ Navigation System
: w/o Navigation System
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE
: Except 6 Speaker
: 6 Speaker
: w/ CD Changer
: w/o CD Changer
G
W–G
H11
Hazard SW
G
G
G
S5
Seat Heater SW RH
4
G
W–G
6
G
W–G
S4
Seat Heater SW LH
6
G
B1
Back Door Power Window
Control SW
G
G
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
G
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–B
W–B
W–G
W–G
165
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Taillight and Illumination
G
(IG)
(IG)
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
∗ 3 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 4 : 1GR–FE
10A
DOME
15A
IG1
2
4 1G
R
2
8 1J
G
R
G
A
A B
D
J7
Junction
Connector
C A
D
R
C A
J7
Junction
Connector
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
10 IC4
R–L
F B
9
15
16
7
13
R
G
G
Y–R
H A
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
Illumination
H A
C10
Combination Meter
4
Tail
(Except USA)
G
1
G3
Glove Box Light
Y–R
1
Illumination
H A
W–B
2
T
A A
BR
BR
A A
BR
W–B
W–B
W–G
W–B
W–G
7 IM1
(∗4)
B 3F
B 3F
E B
(∗3)
3
W–G
5
–
W–G
6
E
W–G
B 3F
ILL–
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
R13
Rheostat
IG
W–G
W–B
A
A
J24
Junction
Connector
W–G
II
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
166
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ED
EE
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A22
36
A38
A42
B1
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
F11
37
36
G3
37
36
H11
37
J40
A
40
36
H12
37
J41
B
40
36
H19
37
B10
40
J5
38
R1
A
39
C7
37
J7
38
R2
B
39
C10
37
J8
A
38
R3
C
39
C12
37
J9
B
38
R5
D
39
C13
37
J10
A
38
R10
A
39
C15
37
J11
B
38
R12
B
39
D3
37
J14
A
38
R13
39
D4
37
J15
B
38
R14
41
D5
37
J16
A
38
R15
41
37
J17
B
38
R25
39
32 (2UZ–FE)
J20
A
38
S4
39
38
S5
39
B6
C
E7
D
F5
34 (1GR–FE)
F6
J24
32 (2UZ–FE)
J31
A
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J32
B
38
J37
38
J39
40
M2
39
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1C
1F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1L
3D
3E
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
II1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IR1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Cigarette Lighter Wiring Assembly (Rear Console)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BH1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Back Door No.2 Wire (Left Side of Back Door)
167
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Taillight and Illumination
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
EE
168
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
169
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Stop Light
(BAT)
(IG)
15A
IG1
10A
STOP
2
20 1E
Y–R
2
G–W
E
J1
Junction
Connector
E
D
D
Y–R
Y–R
2
2
S12
Stop Light
SW
5
1
3
2
4
2
G–B
G–Y
G–Y
2
2
LG
1
B
2
STOP LP CTRL
Relay
G–W
B
J4
Junction
Connector
16
STPO
J4
Junction
Connector
E
E
170
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
G–B
G–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
6
BL
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
4
A A
A A
A A
(∗1)
2 B
W–B
1 B
H18(A)
High Mounted
Stop Light
1
(∗1)
G–Y
(∗2)
G–Y
TAIL Fuse
G–Y
TAIL Fuse
G–Y
B A
(∗2)
4
W–B
H18(B)
High Mounted
Stop Light
G
G
G–Y
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
Stop/Tail
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
Stop/Tail
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
1
W–B
W–B
G–B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Spoiler
∗ 2 : w/o Rear Spoiler
G–Y
C B
B A
3 BD1
16 1F
24 1E
1 A
2 A
6
10 BD1
A A
A B
BO
171
Stop Light
: Parts Location
Code
H18
See Page
Code
A
40
B
40
J40
33 (2UZ–FE)
J41
J1
See Page
J4
35 (1GR–FE)
2
See Page
22
41
A
40
S12
39
B
40
R14
41
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1E
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
BD1
See Page
48
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
See Page
R15
: Relay Blocks
Code
Code
38
Ground Points Location
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
172
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
Memo
173
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Back–Up Light
(IG)
15A
IG1
Y–R
8 1J
R–Y
A
J7
Junction
Connector
B
A
Y–R
1 IM1
J20
Junction
Connector
R–Y
B
R–Y
H
J33
Junction
Connector
H
Y–R
2 1L
A
1
R
J25
Junction
Connector
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
10 1F
2
Y–R
R–Y
A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
B B
2 IM1
W–B
A A
A A
A A
R–Y
1 BG1
Y
6
W–B
6
C A
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
R–Y
2
Back–Up
3
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
C A
Back–Up
C A
R–Y
Y–R
4
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
A B
W–B
W–B
B/UP
BO
174
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BL
T15
Trailer
Socket
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J7
38
J40
A
40
R14
41
J20
38
J41
B
40
R15
41
J25
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
T15
41
J33
38
P1
35 (1GR–FE)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1F
1J
1L
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
BG1
48
Floor No.2 Wire and Frame No.3 Wire (Rear Side of Side Frame LH)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
175
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
IGT1
24
IGF1
LG–B
8
LG
1
3
2
W–R
W–R
B–R
4
1
3
2
IGT2
LG
W–R
W–R
IGT3
Battery
E4
Engine Control Module
64
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B–R
W–B
4
1
4
3
2
LG–B
W–R
30A
AM2
W–B
I4
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
W–B
B–R
B–R
I18
Ignition SW
I3
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
B–R
4
P–L
2
W–R
I2
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
3
W–B
B–R
2
1
Y–R
R
IG2 6
P–L
W–R
2
I1
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
R
7 AM2
Y–R
B
Ignition for 1GR–FE
B–R
ST2
6 1D
4 1H
13 IM1
B–R
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
1
W–R
W–R
2
9
10
11
IGT4
W–R
IGT5
N1
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 1)
I6
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
B–R
W–B
1
4
1
4
3
2
12
13
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–R
2
W–R
B–R
W–B
L
3
GR
B–R
W–B
L
W–B
GR
I5
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
B–R
2
1
W–R
IGT6
E4
Engine Control Module
EF
65
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Ignition for 1GR–FE
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
E4
37
I3
35 (1GR–FE)
I6
35 (1GR–FE)
I1
35 (1GR–FE)
I4
35 (1GR–FE)
I18
37
I2
35 (1GR–FE)
I5
35 (1GR–FE)
N1
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1D
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IM1
See Page
47
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
: Ground Points
Code
EF
See Page
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block
66
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
67
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Key Reminder
(BAT)
(IG)
(ACC)
10A
ECU–IG
10A
ECU–B
(IG)
7. 5A
ACC
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
10A
DOME
2
2
2
R–L
W–R
4 1G
R
4 1B
11
10
BECU
22
ACC
SIG
B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
E A
F A
GND1
DCY2
KSWO
11 C
10 IC4
15 C
8 C
19 B
R
4
2 1H
W–B
G–Y
A B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
R–B
H B
16
V–G
14 C
W–L
GND2
KSW
DCTY
23 B
F B
7 IM1
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
2
K3
Unlock Warning SW
G–Y
A
W–B
BR
(1GR–FE)
BR
W–B
A B
J15(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
(2UZ–FE)
W–B
R
1
A
IG
J5
Junction
Connector
ED
EE
176
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
D
D
R
R
15 C
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
16 C
BR
C B
13 C
R–L
B A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
1
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
R–B
G–Y
Buzzer
J7
Junction
Connector
System Outline
Key Reminder System
With the ignition key inserted in the key cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), the ignition SW still off and driver’s door open
(Door courtesy SW on), when a signal is input to TERMINAL (B) 23 of the body ECU, the body ECU operates, current flows
from TERMINAL (C) 15 of the ECU to TERMINAL (B) 19 of the combination meter to GROUND and key reminder buzzer
sounds.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B5
B
36
B6
C
36
C9
B
37
C
C10
D12
Code
See Page
J5
J7
Code
See Page
38
J15
B
38
38
J18
A
38
J8
A
38
J19
B
38
37
J9
B
38
40
J14
A
38
K3
39
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1G
1H
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
: Ground Points
Code
ED
EE
IG
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
46
Left Kick Panel
177
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Seat Belt Warning
G–Y
(BAT)
(IG)
(ACC)
10A
ECU–IG
10A
ECU–B
7. 5A
ACC
(IG)
(BAT)
15A
IG1
2
(IG)
10A
DOME
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
2
8 1J
4 1G
R
R–L
Y–R
G–Y
W–R
2
A
J7
Junction
Connector
R
A
10 IC4
4 1B
11
10
BECU
22
SIG
13 A
DBKL
ACC
Y–R
D
J7
Junction
Connector
D
R–L
GND1
R
GND2
16
B 4(A)
Body ECU
4
H A
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
H A
Y–R
W–B
2 1H
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE
: w/ Side Airbag
: w/o Side Airbag
: w/ Driving Position Memory
: w/o Driving Position Memory
: w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
: w/o Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
A
J25
Junction
Connector
A
R
W–B
Y–R
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
Y–R
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
178
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
BR
Y–R
A 3C
ED
4 BI1
8
4
FSR+
FSR–
BSW
BGND
9
5
2 A
2 B
1 A (∗7)
1 B (∗8)
B16(A), (B)
Buckle SW RH
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(∗5)
1 BI1
W–B
F B
(∗5)
FSR–
2 D (∗3)
10 E (∗4)
W–B
PBEW
(∗5)
2 C
L
(∗5)
L
(∗6)
PBEW
K B
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction Connector
3
W–B
A 3C
(∗5)
G–Y
(∗6)
G–Y
G–Y
G–Y
Buzzer
(∗6)
FSR+
W–B
1 D
3 E
G–Y
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
D A
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction Connector
IG+
A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
G–Y
13 B
B
B B
(∗6)
W–B
R
L–R
BR
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
O3
Occupant
Classification ECU
H A
B
2
GR
W
7 IM1
W
BR
(∗1)
13 C
L
BR
(∗2)
18 B
(∗1)
H A
B
BR
1
Y–R
LG
16 C
R
R–L
D3
Passenger Seat Belt
Warning Light
R
15 C
(∗2)
R
R
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
Driver' s
Seat Belt
G–Y
G–Y
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction Connector
D A
C A
26 IE1
12 B
C B
D A
10 BK1
3
B15
Buckle SW LH
4
B
J53
Junction
Connector
A B
B
A A
1 BK1
BL
179
Seat Belt Warning
System Outline
When the driver has not fastened the seat belt while the ignition SW is ON, the driver seat belt warning light blinks, and a
warning buzzer comes on.
Also, in the front passenger seat, a sensor recognizes passenger, and when the passenger has not fastened the seat belt,
the front passenger seat belt warning light blinks.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A32
C
36
B16
B
43 (*2)
A33
D
36
C9
B
37
A34
E
36
C10
C
37
B4
A
36
D3
37
42 (*1)
J5
38
43 (*2)
J7
38
B15
B16
A
B
42 (*1)
J8
A
38
43 (*2)
J9
B
38
42 (*1)
J20
A
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1H
1J
3C
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
BI1
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Front RH Seat)
51 (*2)
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
: Ground Points
Code
ED
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
EE
* 1 : Power Seat
* 2 : Manual Seat
180
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Code
J21
See Page
B
J25
38
J43
A
J44
B
J53
O3
38
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
Memo
181
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Garage Door Opener
(BAT)
10A
DOME
2
R
2
R
2
5
2
2
DOME
Relay
3
1
2
R
R–W
2
6 1E
R
1 IC3
4 1A
R
3
LMRY
5
B4
Body ECU
P7
Personal Light
B
Garage
Door
Opener
E
W–B
1
12 1A
W–B
2 1H
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
182
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B4
Code
36
J5
See Page
38
Code
P7
See Page
41
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1E
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IC3
See Page
46
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
IG
See Page
46
Ground Points Location
Left Kick Panel
183
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Front Wiper and Washer
(IG)
30A
FR WIP–WSH
C14
Combination SW
22 1E
9 1J
11
6
IN1
L–Y
L
L
INT TIME
Washer
HI
LO
INT
OFF
Wiper Relay
L–Y
2
1
M
L
W2
Washer Motor
L–W
16
IC4
L–W
7
L–B
14
IC4
L–B
8
L–R
17
IC4
L–R
17
L–W
16
L
L
W–B
L
2
2
3
L
4
1
W–B
Front Wiper and Washer SW
A
J15
Junction
Connector
M
A
A
5
W–B
W–B
F7
Front Wiper Motor
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
184
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EB
System Outline
With the ignition SW turned on, the current flows to TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW, TERMINAL 1 of the washer
motor and TERMINAL 2 of the front wiper motor through the FR WIP–WSH fuse.
1. Low Speed Position
With the wiper and washer SW turned to LO position, the current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to
TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 1 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 5 to GROUND and causes the front wiper motor to run
at low speed.
2. High Speed Position
With the wiper and washer SW turned to HI position, the current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to
TERMINAL 8 to TERMINAL 4 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 5 to GROUND and causes the front wiper motor to run
at high speed.
3. INT Position
With the wiper and washer SW turned to INT position, the wiper relay operates and current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the
wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND. This activates the intermittent circuit and the current flows from
TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 1 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 5 to
GROUND and the wiper operates. Intermittent operation is controlled by a condenser charge and discharge function in the
relay.
4. Washer Interlocking Operation
With the wiper and washer SW pulled to washer position (Washer SW ON position), the current flows from the FR WIP–WSH
fuse to TERMINAL 1 of the washer motor to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 11 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 2 to
GROUND and causes the washer motor to run and the window washer to spray. Simultaneously, current flows from the FR
WIP–WSH fuse to TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 1 of the front wiper motor to
TERMINAL 5 to GROUND, causing the wiper to function.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
C14
F7
Code
See Page
37
J5
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J15
38
34 (1GR–FE)
W2
33 (2UZ–FE)
Code
W2
See Page
35 (1GR–FE)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1E
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
EB
IG
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
46
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
Left Kick Panel
185
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Rear Wiper and Washer
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
10A
ECU–IG
(IG)
7. 5A
ACC
15A
RR
WSH
WIG
1
ACC
22
BECU
GND2
10
11
16
8 1F
4 1B
12 1F
W–R
10A
ECU–B
(ACC)
W–R
(IG)
B–R
(BAT)
SIG
GND1
4
2
W–R
2
W–B
W–B
2 1H
W–R
J5
Junction
Connector
B–R
A
A
IG
186
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
W–B
J15
Junction
Connector
W–B
Rear Wiper and
Washer SW
10 C
RWON
C A
B A
B A
12
10
C14
Combination SW
2
9 C
RWINT
7 IH1
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BR–R
BR–W
2
BR–W
C A
GR–R
2
GR–R
B–O
WMTR
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction Connector
A B
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
4
D24
Diode
(Rear Wiper)
1
GR–R
LG–B
M
LG–B
LG–B
B B
3 IC3
LG–B
W2
Washer Motor
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
23 A
MPX2
1 1B
3
40 IE1
BR–R
Washer
OFF
LO
HI
Washer
13
A
A
W–R
W–R
B–R
B–R
W–B
187
Rear Wiper and Washer
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
W–B
L–R
B
5 BD1
W–R
B–R
5
6
3
F
E
2
SSRB
6
PLS
3
PLS2
5 A
SIG
7 BD1
1
BR–R
BECU
10 BD1
R
9 BD1
GND
3 A
W–B
LSE
21 B
B–R
FULL
7 B
G–Y
HALF
6 B
R–G
IC–
23 B
L–W
IC1
16 B
B–O
IC2
17 B
W–R
IC+
11 B
Y–G
MPX2
1 A
6 A
E
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
B11
Back Door Power Window Motor
A A
A A
W–B
W–B
A B
W–R
B–R
BO
188
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BL
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
F
E
W–R
B–R
J39
Junction
Connector
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
(BAT)
BDR
4 A
SGND
18 B
P
W
12 B
3 B
WIP+
30A
POWER
WIP–
2 B
1 B
L
2
BR–B
Y–G
R–G
1
3
5
4
L–O
L–O
P–B
G–R
6 BD1
2 1F
Return
Position
Furthest
Position
M
Stop
2
R23
Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Position SW
189
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Rear Wiper and Washer
System Outline
∗ Rear wiper operation
The back door ECU initiates rear wiper intermittent or continuous operation according to rear wiper SW command from the
body ECU. At this point, the position of the back door window is confirmed and, if it is not fully closed, the command will be
neglected preventing the rear wiper from starting.
If the ignition SW is turned OFF while the rear wiper is operating, it comes to a stop but only after the wiper arm has
returned to its initial position.
∗ Rear washer operation
Turning the rear washer SW ON, with the ignition SW ON and the back door window fully closed, initiates rear washer
operation.
: Parts Location
Code
B4
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
A
36
C14
37
J40
B5
B
36
D24
37
J41
B6
C
36
J5
38
B7
40
J12
A
38
J13
B
38
B8
A
40
B9
B
40
J15
38
40
J39
40
B11
See Page
A
40
B
40
R23
W2
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
190
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
41
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
Memo
191
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Window
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
(ACC)
7. 5A
ACC
ACC
22
BDR1
12
BDN
BUP
8 B
10 B
Y–R
20A
DR/LCK
B–L
(BAT)
6
3
COM
19 B
2
2
G–W
DOWN
B–Y
9 1E
1
UP
B1
Back Door Power Window
Control SW
192
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
E
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
KSW
GND1
14 C
GND2
SIG
PWS
16
10
21
G–Y
4
POWER Relay
E A
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
(BAT)
1
(IG)
30A
POWER
5
10A
ECU–IG
2
3
C B
2 1H
1 1H
2 1F
25 1J
8 1F
28 1J
W–B
W
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
B A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
2
G
B–R
2
K3
Unlock Warning SW
G–Y
G
J20
Junction
Connector
W–B
A B
W–B
W–B
A B
J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
1
B–R
W–B
B–R
L–O
A
J5
Junction
Connector
L–O
A
A
W
IG
193
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Window
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
W/L 1
P9
Power Window Control SW
Front RH
A A
B A
B B
C B
B A
A A
L–R
7 IA2
12 IA2
R
5 IP2
L–Y
R
9 IP2
R–B
R–B
10 IP2
L–Y
2
B
5
W
4
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
1
L–Y
3
L–R
L
L–R
P13
Power Window Motor Front RH
L–B
2
1
M
W/L 2
22 C
L–Y
24 C
L–R
R
L–Y
R–B
C
W
C
W
C
C
W
W
J33
Junction
Connector
W
W
C
J7
Junction Connector
C
C
W
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
L–O
L–O
W
194
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
D17
Power Window Master SW
RLU
12
RLD
R–L
L
G
11 IA2
10 IA2
9 IA2
6 IA2
6 BA1
L–B
L
1
G–R
L–B
2
7 BA1
G–R
G
5
G–W
6 BB1
2
G–W
G
7 BB1
2
L
G–B
P15
Power Window Motor
Rear RH
B
10
3
5
2
1
3
M
1
M
1
P14
Power Window Motor
Rear LH
RRD
16
G–B
2 IA2
RRU
18
L–O
12 IA1
B–R
5 IA2
W
R
BW
7
B
B2
11
B
B
6
R–B
PU
13
R
PD
15
R
R–B
W
W
P11
Power Window Control
SW Rear RH
5
BB1
P10
Power Window Control
SW Rear LH
5 BA1
W
W
4
W
4
W
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
L–O
195
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Window
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
L2
UL3
12 A
20
D17
Power Window Master SW
BZR
BZR2
9
7
10 1B
6 1B
3
PLS
14
PLS2
17
GND
2
E
1
W–B
6 IA1
4
5
3
6
D
U
SSRB
PLS
PLS2
E
M
2
B
9
10
7
J38
Junction
Connector
B
W–B
B
P12
Power Window Motor Front LH
G
2
L
1
8 IA1
D16
Door Key Lock and
Unlock SW Front LH
BR–B
W–G
W–R
W–L
L
L–B
1
W3
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
VCC
G
DU
4
L
DD
9
Y–B
P–B
3 1K
W–B
W–B
4 IA2
W–B
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
196
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
RDA
PRG
4 B
DCTY
3 B
PCTY
23 B
RLCY
24 B
RRCY
11 B
12 B
2
P–L
37 IE1
6 IO3
R
R–B
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
1
41 IE1
R
39 IE1
G–O
38 IE1
L–R
R
D
1
D14
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
1
J7
Junction
Connector
D13
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
D
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
R
P–L
10 IC4
P–B
L–R
G–O
F A
P–B
H B
2
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
10A
DOME
R–Y
R–B
(BAT)
2
3
5
RDA
PRG
+B
E
1
D7
Door Control Receiver
A A
A A
W–B
W–B
A B
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
BO
BL
197
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Window
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
BECU
MPX2
MPX2
23 A
11
BECU
1 A
5 A
GND
3 A
SIG
BDR
6 A
4 A
W–B
B
L
40 IE1
9 BD1
7 BD1
10 BD1
5 BD1
6 BD1
W–B
B–R
L–O
W–R
W–R
2
W–R
2
L–R
12 1F
R
4 1B
10A
ECU–B
BR–R
(BAT)
BR–R
F
E
J39
Junction
Connector
F
E
B–R
J39
Junction
Connector
W–B
B–R
L–O
198
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
IC–
HALF
FULL
LSE
7 B
21 B
4
5
1
2
6
3
5
6
3
R
G
SSRB
PLS
PLS2
E
Y–G
B–R
6 B
G–Y
23 B
R–G
1
IC1
16 B
L–W
2
IC2
17 B
B–O
3
IC+
11 B
W–R
R–B
BDDN
25 B
Y–B
BDUP
13 B
V–Y
UP
5 B
GR–R
DOWN
4 B
LG–B
E
19 B
T10
Tailgate Control SW
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
M
B11
Back Door Power Window Motor
199
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Window
System Outline
∗ The power window system is controlled by the body ECU. This system has following features.
1. Manual Up and Down Function
This function causes the window to open or close while the power window switch is being pulled halfway up or pushed
halfway down. The window stops as soon as the switch is released.
2. Front Doors One–Touch Auto Up and Down Function
The front doors one–touch auto up and down function enables the window of front doors to be fully opened or closed at a
touch of the power window switch.
3. Jam Protection Function
A jam protection function automatically stops the power window and moves it downward if a foreign object gets jammed in
the window during one–touch auto–up operation.
4. Remote Control Function
The up and down operations of the front passenger door window and the rear door windows can be controlled by operating
the power window master switch.
5. Ker–Off Operation Function
Within about 45 seconds when turn OFF the ignition SW or open and shut the driver’s seat door, this function enables the
door window operation with the power window master switch and/or the manual operation at each passenger’s seat door.
(The driver’s seat door includes the one–touch auto up and down operation as well)
6. Key–Linked Up and Down Function
A key–linked up and down function, which is linked to the driver door key cylinder operation, open or close the window of the
all doors.
∗ When the battery terminal or fuse is disconnected, the glass position of all doors have to be reset to the initial positions,
door by door, by the power window control switch in accordance with the following procedure:
A) Reconnect the battery terminal or fuse.
B) Turn ON the ignition switch.
C) Lower the window of each door by the power window switch to open it halfway or more.
D) Then move the window up by the power window switch to close it fully.
Do not release the switch for at least one second after the window is fully closed.
7. Back Window Control
When the ignition SW is off, the ignition key is not inserted into the ignition key cylinder, the back window can be opened by
pressing the back window open SW of the transmitter for approximately 0.8 seconds. At that time, the wireless door lock
buzzer beeps once.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B1
Code
See Page
36
D17
40
A
36
J5
38
B5
B
36
B6
C
36
J14
A
40
J15
B4
B7
Code
J41
See Page
B
40
K3
39
38
P9
41
38
P10
41
B
38
P11
41
J7
B8
A
40
J18
A
38
P12
41
B9
B
40
J19
B
38
P13
41
38
P14
41
A
38
P15
41
B
38
T10
41
B11
40
J20
D7
40
J22
D12
40
J23
D13
40
J33
38
D14
40
J38
40
D15
40
J39
40
D16
40
J40
A
40
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
200
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W3
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1E
1F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
1J
1K
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IP2
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
IA2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
201
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Door Lock Control
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
20A DR/LCK
(ACC)
7. 5A ACC
(BAT)
7. 5A GAUGE
(IG)
10A DOME
(BAT)
15A IG1
(IG)
ACC
22
DRLP
BDR1
12
12 C
DCY2
11 C
SPD
14
2
2
1 1G
V–R
R–L
9 1E
W–L
2
V–Y
4 1G
2
R
8 1J
SP1
12
GR–R
Y–R
G–W
J7
Junction
Connector
R
10 IC4
A
S28
Skid Control
ECU with
Actuator
7 IC2
GR–R
Y–R
D
J7
Junction
Connector
A
D
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
J25
Junction
Connector
F B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
H A
A
Speedometer
H A
4 B
5 B
Door
H A
8 C
R
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
17 A
Y–R
R
A
15 C
16 C
R
BR
2 IM1
13 C
R–L
2
BR
(∗1)
BR
∗ 1 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 2 : 1GR–FE
(∗2)
Y–R
7 IM1
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
P
6
G–B
EE
202
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BR
(∗1)
BR
(∗2)
G–B
ED
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
RRCY
L1
12 B
P–L
P–B
1
E A
8
5
1 1K
A
D
A
D
L–W
L–O
L–W
D
L–O
R–W
4 IA1
A
L–W
G–W
5 IA1
L–O
L–W
B
B
B
W–B
J38
Junction
Connector
W–B
G–B
5 1K
P–L
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
1
D14
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
D13
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
J 8(A)
Junction Connector
E A
1
J6
Junction
Connector
L
15
6 IO3
P–B
R–B
G–B
1
UL
L–O
37 IE1
W–B
F A
E
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
H B
UL1
19
L–O
RLCY
11 B
R–Y
R–B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
C A
24 B
D17
Door Lock Control SW Front LH
G–B
C B
PCTY
23 B
L–W
DCTY
P
17 B
C
J35
Junction
Connector
W–B
C
G–B
4 IA2
W–B
8 IM1
G–B
203
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Door Lock Control
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
L2
20
UL3
12 A
LSWD
21 A
ACTD
10 A
LSWP
30 A
ACT+
ACT–
23
24
9 1L
18 1L
3 1K
B–W
G
W–R
L–B
B–W
L–B
L–R
8 IA1
7 IA1
13 IA2
8 IA2
7 IP1
7 IP2
2 IP2
G
W
B–R
B–W
B
B–R
B–W
9
10
8
1
4
7
1
4
L–R
L
6 IA1
L
6 1L
W–B
5 IP1
3
W–B
W–B
L–W
6 IP1
L–O
L
6
R
5
Lock
Unlock
D18
Door Lock Control SW
Front RH
L–O
4 IP2
M
W–B
W–B
7
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Lock Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor Front LH
M
8
W–B
L–W
D19
Door Lock Detection
SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor
Front RH
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
204
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
GND2
14 C
GND1
4
L
DBKL
14 A
13 A
GR
G–Y
16
G–Y
KSW
LSR
5
W–B
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction Connector
D A
GR
E A
A A
B B
G–Y
A B
E B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
10 1L
L–R
22 1L
L–B
15 1K
W
11 1L
L–R
23 1L
L–B
W
16 1L
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
2 1H
L–R
6
1
4
C B
GR
M
G–Y
M
1 EA1 (∗1)
3 EA2 (∗2)
4 BB1
10 BK1
K B
L
L
2
K3
Unlock Warning SW
W–B
4 BA1
D A
4
D21
Door Lock Detection SW
Rear RH
Door Lock Motor Rear RH
9
W–B
D20
Door Lock Detection SW
Rear LH
Door Lock Motor Rear LH
W–B
W–B
9
(∗3)
L–B
4
G–Y
W
1
G2
Generator
L
L–R
6
(∗3)
G–Y
L–B
B A
6 IC4
(∗4)
12 BB1
G–Y
11 BB1
(∗4)
10 BB1
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction Connector
12 BA1
GR
11 BA1
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction Connector
10 BA1
W
26 IE1
3
B15
Buckle SW LH
1
J53
Junction
Connector
(∗3)
(∗4)
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction Connector
W–B
B
B
(∗3)
A B
W–B
A B
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE
: w/ Driving Position Memory
: w/o Driving Position Memory
W–B
A A
A
A
A
(∗3)
W–B
(∗4)
1 BK1
W–B
1
2
3
4
W–B
∗
∗
∗
∗
W–B
A B
J15(B)
Junction Connector
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
4
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
BL
205
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Door Lock Control
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
10
2
2
2 1F
R
B–R
1 A
6 BD1 7 BD1
BR–R
40 IE1
5 BD1
9 BD1
F
E
BR–R
W–R
MPX2
SIG
6 A
B
8 1F
BECU
5 A
B–R
4 1B
W–R
12 1F
W–R
BR–R
2
BDR
4 A
L–R
11
30A
POWER
10A
ECU–B
10A
ECU–IG
SIG
W–R
BECU
(BAT)
L–O
MPX2
23 A
(BAT)
L
(IG)
J39
Junction
Connector
F
W–R
B–R
206
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
E
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
6
4
3
1
2
1
M
2
W–B
5
GND
3 A
B10
Back Door Opener SW
LG–R
HSW–
22 B
V–W
HSW+
10 B
L–R
ACT–
14 B
L–B
10 BD1
W–B
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
Back Door Lock Detection SW
Back Door Lock Motor
A A
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
A B
BO
W–B
ACT+
15 B
B–R
LSE
21 B
BR–W
POS
8 B
G–Y
FULL
7 B
R–G
HALF
6 B
BL
207
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Door Lock Control
System Outline
The door lock control is controlled through the various signal input into the body ECU through communication control of the
body ECU etc.
1. Manual Unlock Operation
When the door lock control SW of the driver’s or passenger’s side door is pushed to UNLOCK, the door will unlock.
2. Manual Lock Operation
When the door lock control SW of the driver’s or passenger’s side door is pushed to LOCK, the door will lock.
3. Door Key Unlock Operation
∗ Unlock operation from driver’s side door
When the driver’s side door is unlocked once using the ignition key, only the driver’s side door is unlocked. If this operation
is repeated within 3 seconds, all the other doors are unlocked.
4. Ignition Key Reminder Operation
When the door lock operation is made using the door knob with the ignition key remained inserted in the key cylinder and the
door open, unlock operation is automatically made. Additionally, if lock operation is made with the door lock control SW or
door key lock and unlock SW, unlock operation is automatically made after the lock operation has been completed.
5. Shift–Lever–Interlocked Auto Lock Control
∗ Auto lock operation
The auto lock control automatically locks all the doors when the shift lever is put into other position than parking position
with all the doors closed, the ignition switch ON, and the engine running.
∗ Auto unlocking operation
The auto lock control automatically unlocks all the doors when the shift lever is put into parking position from other position
with the ignition switch ON during traveling at a speed not exceeding 16 km/h.
6. Vehicle–Speed–Interlocked Auto Lock Control
∗ Auto lock operation control
If any of the doors is not locked with the ignition switch ON and the engine running, the auto lock control automatically
locks all the doors when the vehicle has gathered speed reaching or exceeding 20 km/h.
∗ Unlocking prevention feature
When the vehicle is traveling at a speed reaching or exceeding 20 km/h, the unlocking function is disabled.
∗ Auto lock repeat prevention feature
Once auto lock is activated, auto lock operation cannot not be repeated until a door is opened or the ignition switch is
turned OFF with the vehicle traveling at a speed not exceeding 16 km/h.
7. Door–Open/Close–Interlocked Auto Unlocking
When the driver’s side door is opened within 10 seconds after the ignition switch is turned OFF, all the doors are unlocked
automatically.
∗ When the battery terminal or fuse is disconnected for some reason, resetting to the initial status is necessary using the
door lock control SW front LH (Driver’s seat master SW) in accordance with the following procedure:
(1) Reconnect the battery terminal or fuse.
(2) With the back door closed, operate the door lock control SW front LH (Driver’s seat master SW) for locking and
unlocking.
208
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
B4
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A
36
D18
40
J35
38
B5
B
36
D19
40
J37
38
B6
C
36
D20
40
J38
40
40
D21
40
J39
B7
B8
A
40
B9
B
40
B10
B15
G2
40
32 (2UZ–FE)
J40
A
40
34 (1GR–FE)
J41
B
40
J43
A
J44
B
40
J5
38
42 (*1)
J6
38
43 (*2)
J7
38
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
C8
A
37
J8
A
38
C9
B
37
J9
B
38
J53
42 (*1)
C10
C
37
J14
A
38
K3
39
D12
40
J15
B
38
D13
40
J18
A
38
D14
40
J19
B
38
D15
40
J20
A
38
D16
40
J21
B
38
D17
40
J25
P1
S28
43 (*2)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1E
1F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1H
1J
1K
1L
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
EA2
45 (1GR–FE)
IA1
IA2
IC2
IC4
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
IP1
IP2
* 1 : Power Seat
* 2 : Manual Seat
209
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Door Lock Control
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
EE
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
210
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
211
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Wireless Door Lock Control
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
(BAT)
(BAT)
50A
J/B
(ACC)
20A
DR/LCK
7. 5A
ACC
ACC
22
2
TRLY
HRLY
HAZ
GND2
18
17
8
16
14 1J
2
3
2
5
1
1 1C
8 1B
L–W
W
2 1H
W
10 IF1
W
W
(∗1)
10
HAZ
8
EHW
T9
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
W
R–B
D2
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
(∗2)
W–B
9 1E
G–W
G–W
TAIL Relay
2
(∗2)
2
L–W
BDR1
12
2
2
3
2
5
1
HEAD
Relay
B
2
Battery
212
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
GND1
TOUT
ILE
4
6 A
13
DCTY
PCTY
23 B
RLCY
RRCY
11 B
24 B
12 B
P–B
P–L
R–B
(BAT)
37 IE1
6 IO3
H B
2
9 1K
2
1
P–L
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
2
1
G–R
A A
C A
C A
(Except Limited)
1 1D 13 1K
1 A (∗3)
1 B (∗4)
DOOR
ON
OFF
L2
Luggage Compartment
Light
DOOR
ON
OFF
I20(A), (B)
Interior Light
R
2
3
1
G–R
3
1
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
R
W
C B
2 A (∗3)
2 B (∗4)
3 A
3 B
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
W
(∗3)
W(∗3)
W(∗4)
W(∗4)
(∗3)
2
W(∗4)
5
GR–B
W(∗3)
6
HORN Relay
I17
Ignition Key
Cylinder Light
W
(∗3)
P–B
10 1E
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
R–G
W
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
W–G
W
(∗4)
F A
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
8 1A
R–B
7 1A
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
R–Y
10A
HORN
E
J6
Junction
Connector
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
E
B B
1
W(∗4)
W
W(∗4)
(∗3)
R
G–R
∗
∗
∗
∗
W
1
2
3
4
: w/ Daytime Running Light
: w/o Daytime Running Light
: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
(∗3)
W(∗3)
9 1A
22 1J
6 1E
R–W
R–W
W–B
W–B
213
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Wireless Door Lock Control
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
MPX3
KSW
26 C
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
B 3E
BR–B
2
A 3D
B 3E
1
T1
Theft Deterrent
Horn
W–B
B–R
W–R
2
A B
J12(A)
Junction
Connector
G–R
A B
G
D A
D A
B–R
G
1
W3
Wireless Door
Lock Buzzer
A 3D
J20
Junction
Connector
Y–B
C B
2
2 IN1
1
6 1B
P–B
+B1
10
W–R
W–B
IG
T5
Theft Deterrent
ECU
B–R
G–R
1
BR–B
29
B A
MPX1
SH–
E
5
31
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
HORN
10 1B
E A
12
KSW
7
A B
K3
Unlock Warning SW
W–L
+B2
BZR2
J15(B)
Junction
Connector
B–R
3
A B
G–Y
10 1K
B B
BZR
9
G–Y
28 1J
B B
BR–Y
8 1F
B–R
10A
SECU/HORN
G–Y
10A
ECU–IG
BR–Y
BR–Y
(BAT)
G–Y
(IG)
14 C
G–Y
SIG
10
B–R
W–B
W–B
B–R
W–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
W–B
W–B
A
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
214
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A
J5
Junction Connector
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
LSWD
ACTD
10 A
LSWP
30 A
ACT+
ACT–
LSR
23
24
5
9 1L
18 1L
B–W
21 A
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
13 IA2
8 IA2
7 IP1
7 IP2
2 IP2
10 BA1
11 BA1
12 BA1
10 BB1
11 BB1
12 BB1
B–W
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
8
1
4
7
1
4
6
1
4
6
1
4
L–R
7 IA1
B–R
10 1L
B
22 1L
B–W
15 1K
L–B
11 1L
B–R
23 1L
W–R
16 1L
W
6 1L
J38
Junction
Connector
4 IP2
9
D20
Door Lock Detection SW
Rear LH
Door Lock Motor Rear LH
M
9
W–B
D19
Door Lock Detection SW
Front RH
Door Lock Motor
Front RH
W–B
8
M
4 BA1
4 BB1
W–B
B
D16
Door Lock Detection SW
Front LH
Door Lock Motor Front LH
W–B
W–B
7
M
W–B
M
D21
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear RH
Door Lock Motor
Rear RH
W–B
W–B
B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
4 IA2
W–R
W–R
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
A
A
A
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
215
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Wireless Door Lock Control
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
RDA
PRG
4 B
LMRY
3 B
DRLP
12 C
3 A
G–O
D
38 IE1
39 IE1
41 IE1
J7
Junction Connector
R
R
10 IC4
1 IC3
R
R
R
D
V–Y
L–R
D
G–O
R
2
3
5
RDA
PRG
10A
DOME
+B
R
L–R
(BAT)
17 A
2
Door
R
D7
Door Control
Receiver
W–B
1
R
W–B
2
2
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
2
E
16 C
5
A A
A B
DOME
Relay
3
1
2
10 BD1
R
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
2
2
R–W
W–B
W–B
W–B
R
F B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
H A
W–R
W–R
B–R
B–R
R–W
BO
W–B
W–B
W–B
BL
216
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
(BAT)
23 A
11
BDR
4 A
MPX2
BECU
1 A
5 A
SIG
GND
6 A
3 A
W–B
30A
POWER
MPX2
BECU
2
(BAT)
R
L–R
B
5 BD1
W–R
B–R
F
E
W–R
W–R
W–R
BR–R
W–R
7 BD1
BR–R
40 IE1
2
2
9 BD1
6 BD1
L–O
10A
ECU–B
L
12 1F
L–O
4 1L
BR–R
2 1F
4 1B
F
E
B–R
J39
Junction
Connector
W–R
B–R
W–B
217
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Wireless Door Lock Control
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
B–R
LSE
21 B
L–R
ACT–
14 B
L–B
ACT+
15 B
BR–W
POS
8 B
G–Y
FULL
7 B
R–G
HALF
6 B
5
6
4
1
2
3
M
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
Back Door Lock Detection SW
Back Door Lock Motor
218
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
System Outline
Door lock control (Lock and unlock), back window control (Back window open) and panic control (Theft alarm and flash) is
performed by remote control, without the ignition key inserted in the door key cylinder, using low–power electrical waves
emitted by a transmitter.
1. Normal Operation
∗ Lock operation
When the lock SW on the transmitter is pressed, all the doors are locked.
∗ Unlock operation
When the unlock SW on the transmitter is pressed once, only the driver door is unlocked. When the unlock SW is pressed
again within 3 seconds, all the doors are unlocked.
2. Auto Lock Function
When the door is not actually opened within 30 seconds after the door has been unlocked by the unlock SW on the
transmitter, all the doors are automatically locked. If any of the following conditions are detected, the wireless door lock does
not function.
∗ Any door is opened.
∗ The ignition key is inserted into the ignition SW.
∗ When the lock detection SW of all the doors are locked.
3. Wireless Door Lock Stop Function
If any of the following conditions are detected, the wireless door lock does not function.
Lock operation
∗ When any door is open (Door courtesy SW on)
∗ The ignition key is inserted into the ignition SW (Unlock warning SW on)
∗ Ignition SW is on
Unlock operation
∗ Ignition SW is on
4. Buzzer Sound Function
During lock operation, when the body ECU receives a lock signal from the door lock detection SW, the wireless door lock
buzzer goes on once. During unlock operation, when the body ECU receives an unlock signal from the door lock detection
SW, the wireless door lock buzzer goes on twice.
With any door open, when the body ECU receives a lock signal from the transmitter, the wireless door lock buzzer goes on
for approx. 10 seconds. If the door is closed, or ignition SW is on, or if the unlock signal is received from the transmitter while
the buzzer is on, the buzzer stops.
5. Visual Confirmation of Lock or Unlock
During lock operation, when the body ECU receives a lock signal from the door lock detection SW, the turn signal light is
flashed once. During unlock operation, when the body ECU receives an unlock signal from the door lock detection SW, the
turn signal light is flashed twice.
6. Remote Panic Operation
Panic will function when doors are locked or unlocked, open or closed. When the panic button (Transmitter) is pushed once,
interior lights light up, and theft alarm and horn sounds and turn signal light, headlights and taillight flash. Then, the panic or
the unlock button (Transmitter) is pushed once more, interior lights are turned off, sounding and flashing will stop. Panic will
not function when ignition key is in ignition key cylinder.
7. Repeat Function
If the lock detection signal in response to the output signal is not received after the body ECU has output the lock signal, the
lock signal is output again.
8. Buzzer Volume Control
The volume of the wireless door lock buzzer can be set among 5 steps by operating the transmitter, when the ignition SW is
off, any door open, and the ignition key is not in the ignition key cylinder.
9. Illuminated Entry Function
When the body ECU detects the unlock state after the unlock operation has been made, it turns on the lights, such as the
ignition key cylinder light and interior light for approx. 15 sec. If all the doors are locked during this operation, lighting is
cancelled and the lights immediately fade out.
219
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Wireless Door Lock Control
: Parts Location
Code
B4
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A
36
D20
40
J20
38
B5
B
36
D21
40
J24
38
B6
C
36
I17
37
J37
38
A
40
J38
40
B
40
J39
B7
40
I20
B8
A
40
B9
B
40
J5
38
J40
A
40
C8
A
37
J6
38
J41
B
40
C
37
C10
J7
40
38
K3
39
D2
37
J8
A
38
L2
40
D7
40
J9
B
38
D12
40
J12
A
38
D13
40
J13
B
38
T5
39
D14
40
J14
A
38
T9
39
D15
40
J15
B
38
D16
40
J18
A
38
D19
40
J19
B
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
1H
1J
1K
1L
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IA2
IC3
IC4
IF1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Relay Wire (Behind the Instrument Panel J/B)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
IP1
IP2
220
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
T1
W3
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
221
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Theft Deterrent
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
(BAT)
(BAT)
50A
J/B
(ACC)
20A
DR/LCK
7. 5A
ACC
ACC
22
BDR1
TRLY
HRLY
GND2
12
18
17
16
GND1
ILE
4
13
7 1A
8 1A
2
3
2
5
1
1 1C
L–W
8 1B
2 1H
W–B
9 1E
W
TAIL Relay
2
G–W
L–W
2
G–W
2
W
W
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
(∗4)
W
(∗3)
W(∗3)
W
(∗3)
W(∗4)
DOOR
2
ON
OFF
3
L2
Luggage Compartment
Light
DOOR
W(∗3)
2 A (∗3)
2 B (∗4)
ON
OFF
3 A
3 B
1 A (∗3)
1 B (∗4)
W
R–B
I20(A), (B)
Interior Light
W(∗4)
W(∗4)
1
W
W(∗4)
3
2
2
W(∗3)
(∗3)
W(∗4)
2
W(∗3)
HEAD
Relay
W(∗4)
5
1
B
2
Battery
222
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
PCTY
RLCY
RRCY
24 B
11 B
P–L
DCTY
23 B
P–B
LMRY
3 A
R–Y
HAZ
8
37 IE1
6 IO3
DRLP
12 B
12 C
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
10A
DOME
H B
2
1 IC3
2
14 1J
D2
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
T9
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
1
R
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
P–L
P–B
R
16 C
2
R
R–W
2
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
3
8
1
D14
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
EHW
2
1
D13
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
HAZ
2
DOME Relay
5
W
(∗2)
2
Door
R
1
10 IF1
10
17 A
R–B
W
R
(∗2)
W
(∗1)
R
F A
V–Y
R
R–B
(BAT)
R
6 1E
∗
∗
∗
∗
1
2
3
4
: w/ Daytime Running Light
: w/o Daytime Running Light
: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
F B
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
10 IC4
9 1A
D
J7
Junction
Connector
W(∗3)
D
R
W(∗4)
W–B
W–B
223
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Theft Deterrent
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
SIG
TOUT
(BAT)
10
(Except Limited)
G–R
6 A
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
SECU/HORN
10A
ECU–IG
10A
HORN
8 1F
28 1J
B–R
B–R
2
10 1K
G–R
W–L
W–G
2
5
3
HORN
Relay
1 1D 13 1K
IND
E
25
29
DSWH
34
12
P–G
SIND
7
GR–G
2
W–B
GND
3
+B2
W–B
1
HORN
GR–G
5
D3
Security Indicator Light
T5
Theft Deterrent
ECU
10 1E
G–R
E3
Engine Hood
Courtesy SW
B 3F
4
W–B
B 3F
W–B
B B
1
B 3F
W–B
C A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
C A
P–G
G–R
GR–B
6 IC3
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
J24
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
A
II
224
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
W–B
W–B
EB
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
UL3
LSWD
ACTD
12 A
21 A
10 A
L–B
L2
20
W–R
KSW
14 C
G
MPX3
26 C
LSWP
30 A
B A
KSW
MPX1
IG
T5
Theft Deterrent ECU
B–R
W–R
A 3D
B 3E
C B
G
B–W
7 IA1
13 IA2
8 IA2
9
10
8
1
4
B 3E
2
D
W–B
7
W–R
D
8 IA1
M
J12
Junction
Connector
A 3D
G
+B1
2
K3
Unlock Warning SW
J20
Junction
Connector
10
6 IA1
G–Y
SH–
L–R
31
B–W
G–Y
12
B–R
BR–Y
1
L–R
W
G–Y
T1
Theft
Deterrent
Horn
BR–B
1
B–W
G
BR–B
E A
L
A B
L
A B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
G–Y
B B
2 IN1
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction Connector
G–Y
BR–B
B B
BR–Y
3 1K
BR–Y
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Lock Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor Front LH
B
B–R
W–B
B–R
B
A B
W–B
A B
J15(B)
Junction
Connector
B–R
J38
Junction
Connector
4 IA2
W–B
B–R
W–B
1
W–R
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
A
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
225
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Theft Deterrent
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
BECU
11
9 1L
18 1L
16 1L
23 1L
11 1L
15 1K
22 1L
10 1L
4 1L
12 1F
4 1B
L–R
6 1L
W–R
LSR
5
W–R
ACT–
24
W–R
ACT+
23
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
7 IP1
7 IP2
2 IP2
10 BA1
11 BA1
12 BA1
10 BB1
11 BB1
12 BB1
B
B–R
B–W
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
B–W
7
1
4
6
1
4
6
1
4
B–W
L–R
W–R
W–B
4 IP2
4 BA1
D20
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear LH
Door Lock Motor
Rear LH
M
9
W–B
9
W–B
D19
Door Lock Detection
SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor
Front RH
W–B
W–B
8
M
D21
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear RH
Door Lock Motor
Rear RH
4 BB1
W–R
W–B
M
W–R
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
A
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
226
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
FULL
POS
LSE
7 B
8 B
21 B
B–R
HALF
6 B
GND
3 A
L
L–R
B
40 IE1
9 BD1
6 BD1
7 BD1
5 BD1
W–B
R
30A
POWER
2
2
SIG
6 A
(BAT)
10A
ECU–B
2
BECU
5 A
BR–R
(BAT)
BDR
4 A
BR–W
MPX2
1 A
G–Y
MPX2
23 A
R–G
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
10 BD1
2 1F
4
3
W–B
6
B–R
W–R
L–O
L–O
5
W–R
BR–R
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
Back Door Lock Detection SW
F
E
F
E
W–R
B–R
J39
Junction
Connector
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–R
A A
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
A B
BO
BL
227
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Theft Deterrent
: Parts Location
Code
B4
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
36
D19
40
B5
B
36
D20
40
J20
38
B6
C
36
D21
40
J24
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J37
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J38
40
A
40
J39
B
40
J40
J41
B7
40
B8
A
40
B9
B
40
C8
A
37
C
C10
E3
I20
J19
See Page
A
B
38
40
A
40
B
40
37
J5
38
D2
37
J7
38
K3
39
D3
37
J8
A
38
L2
40
D12
40
J9
B
38
D13
40
D14
40
J14
A
38
T5
39
D15
40
J15
B
38
T9
39
D16
40
J18
A
38
J12
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
1H
1J
1K
1L
3D
3E
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IA2
IC3
IC4
IF1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Relay Wire (Behind the Instrument Panel J/B)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
IP1
IP2
228
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
T1
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Ground Points
Code
EB
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
229
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ECT and A/T Indicator for 2UZ–FE
D1
Data Link Connector 3
(BAT)
(BAT)
10A
ETCS
20A
EFI
CANH
13
14
2
P–L
2
TC
CANL
6
2
2
J18
Junction
Connector
V
P
H
1 D
2 D
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
ST–Plug
L
W–G
5
12 IC4
2 E
13 IC4
L
W–B
2
E A
LG
35 IC4
2
1 E
1
A B
8 E
3 E
7 E
P–L
GR
2
2
L
3
W–G
EFI
Relay
2
BATT
34 D
33 D
CANH
+BM
W–B
MREL
B
C 3C
P–L
1 F
C 3C
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
L
GR
P–L
H
23 E
TC
CANL
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
+B
1 E
+B2
2 E
S1
S2
11 B
10 B
SR
9 B
SLT+
13 B
SLT–
12 B
SLU+
15 B
SLU–
14 B
A B
R–B
L–R
P–L
R–W
B
A B
LG–B
B
GR
W–L
B
2
B B
C A
13
SLT–
5
SLU+
SLU–
BR
SB
B
6
SLT+
LG
14
SR
GR
7
S2
W
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
10A
EFI
NO. 2
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
15
S1
G
8
1
B
W–B
B
2
W–B
2
11 IC4
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
J4
Junction
Connector
A
A
L–W
EB
L–W
17
IC3
L–W
12
IM1
IH
230
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L–W
J28
Junction
Connector
C
C
L–W
(BAT)
10A
STOP
2
2
G–Y
A24
Accel Position Sensor
G–W
15 IC3
2
S12
Stop Light SW
VPA1
VPA2
VCP1
VCP2
EP1
EP2
6
3
4
1
5
2
W–R
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
E 3C
1
G–Y
G–Y
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
E 3C
B
H A
34 IC4
31 IC4
26 IC4
9 IC3
29 IC4
8 IC3
J4
Junction
Connector
B
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
18 E
19 E
26 E
27 E
20 E
21 E
VPA
VPA2
VCPA
VCP2
EPA
G–Y
W–R
E B
15 E
EPA2
STP
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VG
30 A
B–W
Y–B
3 B
2 B
4 B
OT2+
E2
+B
5 B
1 B
M 1(B)
Mass Air Flow Meter
THA
L–W
OT2–
1
E2G
BR
L
O
OT–
2
THA
22 A
9
OT+
VG
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
E2G
29 A
W–R
BR
10
SL2–
E2
28 A
L
Y–G
B–R
3
SL2+
THO2
32 B
L
L
R
11
SL1–
THO1
24 B
O
4
SL1+
SL2–
16 B
B–W
B–Y
G–B
12
SL2+
17 B
V
SL1–
18 B
Y
SL1+
19 B
BR
BR
BR
L–W
231
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ECT and A/T Indicator for 2UZ–FE
(ST)
7. 5A
STA
NO. 2
2 1K
4
2
L–Y
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
N
B–Y
5
6 IM2
J28
Junction
Connector
1
T4
Turbine Speed
Sensor
1
V11
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically Controlled
Transmission)
P
2
A
A
B–Y
STA Relay
Y–R
W–R
L–Y
R–L
L–Y
P
B–Y
A
35 B
27 B
34 B
26 B
12 C
8 B
11 C
NT+
NT–
SP2+
SP2–
STSW
STAR/
NSW
STA
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
E01
E1
4WD
E04
E05
1 C
8 C
7 B
6 B
G
R–L
6
4
2
1
2
VTA1
VTA2
M+
M–
5
VC
E2
1
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
BR
W
3
E2
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
R
R
(Shielded)
L–R
7 A
W–B
E03
4 B
W–B
E02
6 A
W–B
ME01
3 B
W–B
THW
21 A
W–B
GE01
17 A
W–B
M–
4 A
W–B
M+
5 A
BR
VTA2
19 A
R–B
VTA1
20 A
Y
VC
23 A
BR
ED
232
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
EE
(IG)
G–R
ATL
AT4
4
3
V
2
G
ATD
5
B–L
NSSD
G 3C
D 3C
D 3E
G 3C
D 3C
D 3E
B A
10 D
9 D
20 D
2
L
4
G
B–L
9 E
IGSW
G B
B B
V
D B
G–R
B B
D A
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
B–O
B B
F A
V
D A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
G
E A
G
B–L
E A
B A
G
G–R
D 3C
G–R
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B–O
G 3C
B–L
B A
B–L
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
B–O
B A
AT2
9
W
NSSL
10
G–R
11 1J
P–L
S6
Transmission Control SW
10A
IGN
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
P
W–B
W–B
OILW
29 D
SPD
8 D
R
D
3
11 D
21 D
19 D
R–Y
EOM
35 D
V–R
EC
9 C
L
L
V
V
G B
W
G
W–B
G A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
W–B
A A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
R–Y
A B
V–R
1 IM2
P–L
B–L
J37
Junction
Connector
A
V–R
P
IK
233
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L
H A
G–W
G–W
H A
H A
A A
A A
C A
C A
L
D B
2 1J
R–Y
V
E B
234
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B A
B A
C B
I A
G–B
G–B
Y–R
J20
Junction
Connector
G–B
A
J35(A)
Junction
Connector
R–Y
J7
Junction
Connector
Y–R
G–R
R–Y
R–Y
G–W
Y–R
J25
Junction
Connector
H
R–Y
V
A
R–Y
V
L
2
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
L
G–R
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
Y–R
G–W
L
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
L
A
G–W
V
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
E B
F B
V
L
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
ECT and A/T Indicator for 2UZ–FE
(IG)
15A
IG1
H
8 1J
2 IM1
A
Y–R
RB
LL
2L
DL
NL
RL
PL
8
3
7
9
1
6
20 IM2
21 IM2
9 IM1
10 IM1
1 IM1
8 IM1
G–R
V
G–B
C A
C A
2 1L
R–Y
R–Y
G–W
W
W
G
G
L
P–L
P–L
B–L
B–L
V–R
V–R
P
P
(IG)
(BAT)
J7
Junction
Connector
D
7. 5A
GAUGE
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
10A
DOME
2
SP1
D
2
12
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
GR–R
R
R
4 1G
7 IC2
GR–R
F B
16 C
4 B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
Speedometer
15 C
10 IC4
R
R–L
H A
E A
A/T OIL TEMP
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
G–B
G–B
4
3
2
L
18 D
17 D
16 D
15 D
14 D
R–Y
G–W
W
G
L
P–L
B–L
5 B
13 C
BR
D
19 D
V–R
N
1 C
G–B
G–B
R
20 D
P
15 A
P
A B
1 1G
R–Y
G–W
7 IM1
11 1K
G
V–R
W
L
B 3D
BR
P–L
B–L
B 3D
V–R
V–R
P
ED
235
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ECT and A/T Indicator for 2UZ–FE
System Outline
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled throttle hydraulic pressure,
governor hydraulic pressure and lock–up hydraulic pressure. The electronically controlled transmission, however, electrically
controls the line pressure, throttle pressure, lock–up pressure and accumulator pressure etc. through the solenoid valve. The
electronically controlled transmission is a system which precisely controls gear shift timing and lock–up timing in response to
the vehicle’s driving conditions and the engine condition detected by various sensors. It makes smooth driving possible by
shift selection for each gear which is the most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time, and by preventing downing,
squat and gear shift shock when starting off.
1. Gear Shift Operation
When driving, the engine warm up condition is input as a signal to TERMINAL THW of the engine control module from the
engine coolant temp. sensor and the vehicle speed signal from vehicle speed sensor is input to TERMINAL SP2+ of the
engine control module. At the same time, the throttle valve opening signal from the throttle position sensor is input to
TERMINALS VTA1 and VTA2 of the engine control module as throttle angle signal.
Based on these signals, the engine control module selects the best shift position for the driving conditions and sends current
to the electronically controlled transmission solenoid.
2. Line Hydraulic Pressure Control
The engine control module adjusts the line hydraulic pressure to the optimal level by controlling TERMINAL SLT+ of the
module according to the engine torque data. This realizes the smooth gear shifting.
3. High Response Gear Shifting Control
The engine control module performs the high response engine torque up control to control the ignition–timing lag as well as
opening the electronic throttle when shifting down. By doing this, the gear shifting is performed in a short period of time.
Moreover, the engine control module uses the orifice switching control, which optimizes the speed of applying and reducing
the hydraulic pressure. And it realizes the fine shifting condition by applying and reducing hydraulic pressure slowly when
the gear shifting shock is important and quickly when the high response is required.
4. Clutch Hydraulic Pressure Control
The engine control module controls the clutch operation in the optimal timing and with the best hydraulic pressure according
to the engine torque data and the number of the clutch revolution
5. Lock–Up and Flexible Lock–Up Control
The engine control module carries out the lock–up control by controlling the TERMINAL SLU+ of the module according to
the shift position, vehicle speed, throttle opening degree and running conditions. The engine control module also steadily
keeps applying the lock–up clutch a delicate slippage to improve the transmission efficiency (Fuel efficiency) of the torque
converter.
6. Stop Light SW Circuit
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) when driving in lock–up condition, a signal is input to TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module. The engine control module operates and cuts the current to the solenoid to release lock–up.
7. AI–Shift Control
The engine control module judges whether the road is downslope or upslope by detecting the throttle opening degree or the
vehicle’s speed. Moreover it can expect the winding roads by detecting the turning condition of the vehicle. The engine
control module keeps unnecessary shifting up from the fourth gear from operating and carries out the automatic shifting
down to the third gear in order to control the vehicle running according to the road conditions. The engine control module
also reads the driver’s intention during driving from his (her) accelerating operation and the running conditions of the vehicle.
As a result of that, ideal shifting patters for each driver are automatically selected without any switching operations.
236
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A24
Code
36
See Page
J4
See Page
J34
B
38
C8
A
37
38
J35
A
38
C9
B
37
J8
A
38
J36
B
38
C10
C
37
J9
B
38
C11
D
37
J10
A
38
J50
D
38
D1
37
J11
B
38
J51
E
38
E1
32 (2UZ–FE)
J18
38
J52
F
38
M1
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
E2
J7
Code
38
J37
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J20
38
E4
A
37
J25
38
P1
33 (2UZ–FE)
E5
B
37
J28
38
S6
39
E6
C
37
J29
A
38
S12
39
E7
D
37
J30
B
38
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
E8
E
37
J31
A
38
T2
33 (2UZ–FE)
J2
A
33 (2UZ–FE)
J32
B
38
T4
33 (2UZ–FE)
J3
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
J33
A
38
V11
33 (2UZ–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1G
1J
1K
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1L
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IC4
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
44 (2UZ–FE)
Front Left Fender
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
EE
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
237
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Charging
W–L
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
B–R
ACC
L–Y
2 1C
6 1D
7 AM2
IG2 6
15A
IG1
7. 5A
GAUGE
B–R
R
4 1G
I18
Ignition SW
2
R–L
2
20 1E
B4
Body ECU
Y–R
W
W–L
ST2
2
15 C
J1
Junction
Connector
2
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
A A
GR
1
E
16 A
GR
140A ALT
E B
E
Y–R
GR
1
Charge
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
L
14
J1
Junction
Connector
50A AM1
∗ 1 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 2 : 1GR–FE
D
D
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
2
2
2
2
2
2 EA1 (∗1)
2 EA2 (∗2)
1 EA1 (∗1)
3 EA2 (∗2)
5 EA1
1 EA2
Y–R
W
Y–R
1
1
GR
30A AM2
7. 5A ALT–S
2
G A
GR
1 B 4 B 2 B
2
L
IG
1 A
B
B
S
Battery
IC Regulator
G 1(A), G 2(B)
Generator
68
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W
GR
B
R
W
6 IC4
Y–R
G B
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B4
36
C8
A
37
C10
C
37
G1
32 (2UZ–FE)
A
34 (1GR–FE)
Code
G2
See Page
B
I18
J1
32 (2UZ–FE)
Code
See Page
J8
A
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J9
B
38
37
J18
A
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
J19
B
38
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
1D
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1E
1G
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
EA2
45 (1GR–FE)
IC4
46
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
69
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ECT and A/T Indicator for 1GR–FE
D1
Data Link Connector 3
(BAT)
(BAT)
10A
ETCS
20A
EFI
CANH
TC
CANL
6
13
14
2
P–L
2
2
2
P
V
J18
Junction
Connector
H
2 D
ST–Plug
L
2 E
W–G
E A
13 IC4
L
2
8 E
3 E
7 E
P–L
GR
1
L
A B
W–G
EFI
Relay
BATT
33 D
+BM
C A
7
14
SR
B
W
S2
SLT–
12 B
6
SLT+
SLU+
15 B
13
SLT–
SLU–
14 B
R–B
P–L
15
S1
SLT+
13 B
R–W
A B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
10A
EFI
NO. 2
TC
5
SLU+
LG
B
GR
B
B
A B
SR
9 B
L–R
S2
10 B
GR
S1
11 B
LG–B
+B2
2 E
SB
+B
1 E
8
B A
23 E
CANL
G
2
2
1
34 D
CANH
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
W–B
2
B
MREL
2
W–L
3
SLU–
BR
5
LG
12 IC4
W–B
35 IC4
2
C 3C
P–L
1 E
1 F
C 3C
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
1 D
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
L
GR
P–L
H
B
W–B
W–B
2
B
2
11 IC4
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
J4
Junction
Connector
A
A
L–W
EB
L–W
17
IC3
L–W
12
IM1
IH
238
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L–W
L–W
(BAT)
10A
STOP
2
2
G–Y
A24
Accel Position Sensor
G–W
15 IC3
2
S12
Stop Light SW
VPA1
VPA2
VCP1
VCP2
EP1
EP2
6
3
4
1
5
2
W–R
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
E 3C
1
G–Y
G–Y
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
E 3C
B
H A
34 IC4
31 IC4
26 IC4
9 IC3
29 IC4
8 IC3
J4
Junction
Connector
B
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
18 E
19 E
26 E
27 E
20 E
21 E
VPA
VPA2
VCPA
VCP2
EPA
G–Y
W–R
E B
15 E
EPA2
STP
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
BR
E2
28 A
R–W
R–B
3 A
2 A
4 A
L
OT2–
1
VG
E2G
THA
+B
E2
1 A
5 A
BR
M 1(A)
Mass Air Flow Meter
L
OT2+
L–W
2
THA
22 A
9
OT+
OT–
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
E2G
29 A
R–Y
10
SL2–
30 A
L
Y–G
B–R
3
SL2+
VG
THO2
32 B
O
L
R
11
SL1–
THO1
24 B
O
4
SL1+
SL2–
16 B
B–W
B–Y
G–B
12
SL2+
17 B
V
SL1–
18 B
Y
SL1+
19 B
BR
BR
BR
L–W
239
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ECT and A/T Indicator for 1GR–FE
(ST)
7. 5A
STA
NO. 2
2 1K
4
2
L–Y
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
N
B–Y
5
4 IM2
J27
Junction
Connector
1
T4
Turbine Speed
Sensor
1
V11
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically Controlled
Transmission)
P
2
B
B
B–Y
STA Relay
R–L
L–Y
L–Y
27 B
34 B
26 B
12 C
NT+
NT–
SP2+
SP2–
B–Y
Y–R
35 B
P
W–R
B
8 B
11 C
STAR/NSW
STSW
STA
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
E03
ME01
E1
E01
E02
3 B
1 C
7 A
6 A
L
B–L
6
4
2
1
2
VTA1
VTA2
M+
M–
VC
E2
W
3
1
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
BR
5
E2
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
R
P
(Shielded)
L–R
4 B
BR
E04
7 B
BR
E05
6 B
BR
THW
21 A
W–B
GE01
17 A
W–B
M–
4 A
W–B
M+
5 A
W–B
VTA2
19 A
G–W
VTA1
20 A
G–B
VC
23 A
BR
EF
240
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
(IG)
G–R
S6
Transmission Control SW
NSSL
ATL
AT4
AT2
ATD
10
4
3
5
2
W
G
D 3C
D 3E
G 3C
D 3C
D 3E
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
E A
E A
G
V
B A
D A
F A
V
G B
A B
9 E
10 D
20 D
9 D
2
4
L
R
D
11 D
21 D
IGSW
B–L
G
B–L
G–R
B B
B–O
D B
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
D A
EOM
3
19 D
OILW
29 D
SPD
8 D
R–Y
V–R
P
V
V
R–Y
G B
G A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
L
W–B
B B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
B B
A B
V
B–L
G 3C
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
B–L
G 3C
G
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G–R
D 3C
B A
35 D
9
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
B A
B–O
B A
NSSD
B–L
G–R
B–O
11 1J
P–L
10A
IGN
W
V–R
W–B
G
P–L
B–L
J37
Junction
Connector
A
V–R
P
IK
L
241
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
V
V
G–W
G–W
H A
A A
A A
C A
C A
E B
L
242
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B A
B A
C B
I A
D B
2 1J
G–B
G–B
Y–R
Y–R
J20
Junction
Connector
G–B
R–Y
J7
Junction
Connector
A
J35(A)
Junction
Connector
G–W
Y–R
J25
Junction
Connector
G–R
R–Y
R–Y
V
H
R–Y
L
A
R–Y
V
H A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
L
G–R
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
2
G–W
L
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
L
Y–R
R–Y
V
L
H A
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
E B
F B
A
G–W
L
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
ECT and A/T Indicator for 1GR–FE
(IG)
15A
IG1
H
8 1J
2 IM1
A
Y–R
RB
LL
2L
DL
NL
RL
PL
8
3
7
9
1
6
20 IM2
21 IM2
9 IM1
10 IM1
1 IM1
8 IM1
G–R
V
G–B
C A
C A
2 1L
R–Y
R–Y
G–W
W
W
G
G
L
P–L
P–L
B–L
B–L
V–R
V–R
P
P
(IG)
(BAT)
J7
Junction
Connector
D
7. 5A
GAUGE
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
10A
DOME
2
D
SP1
2
12
GR–R
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
R
R
4 1G
7 IC2
GR–R
F B
16 C
4 B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
Speedometer
15 C
10 IC4
R
R–L
H A
E A
A/T OIL TEMP
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
G–B
G–B
4
3
2
L
18 D
17 D
16 D
15 D
14 D
R–Y
G–W
W
G
L
P–L
B–L
5 B
13 C
BR
D
19 D
V–R
N
1 C
G–B
G–B
R
20 D
P
15 A
P
A B
1 1G
R–Y
G–W
7 IM1
11 1K
G
V–R
W
L
B 3D
BR
P–L
B–L
B 3D
V–R
V–R
P
EE
243
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ECT and A/T Indicator for 1GR–FE
System Outline
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled throttle hydraulic pressure,
governor hydraulic pressure and lock–up hydraulic pressure. The electronically controlled transmission, however, electrically
controls the line pressure, throttle pressure, lock–up pressure and accumulator pressure etc. through the solenoid valve. The
electronically controlled transmission is a system which precisely controls gear shift timing and lock–up timing in response to
the vehicle’s driving conditions and the engine condition detected by various sensors. It makes smooth driving possible by
shift selection for each gear which is the most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time, and by preventing downing,
squat and gear shift shock when starting off.
1. Gear Shift Operation
When driving, the engine warm up condition is input as a signal to TERMINAL THW of the engine control module from the
engine coolant temp. sensor and the vehicle speed signal from vehicle speed sensor is input to TERMINAL SP2+ of the
engine control module. At the same time, the throttle valve opening signal from the throttle position sensor is input to
TERMINALS VTA1 and VTA2 of the engine control module as throttle angle signal.
Based on these signals, the engine control module selects the best shift position for the driving conditions and sends current
to the electronically controlled transmission solenoid.
2. Line Hydraulic Pressure Control
The engine control module adjusts the line hydraulic pressure to the optimal level by controlling TERMINAL SLT+ of the
module according to the engine torque data. This realizes the smooth gear shifting.
3. High Response Gear Shifting Control
The engine control module performs the high response engine torque up control to control the ignition–timing lag as well as
opening the electronic throttle when shifting down. By doing this, the gear shifting is performed in a short period of time.
Moreover, the engine control module uses the orifice switching control, which optimizes the speed of applying and reducing
the hydraulic pressure. And it realizes the fine shifting condition by applying and reducing hydraulic pressure slowly when
the gear shifting shock is important and quickly when the high response is required.
4. Clutch Hydraulic Pressure Control
The engine control module controls the clutch operation in the optimal timing and with the best hydraulic pressure according
to the engine torque data and the number of the clutch revolution
5. Lock–Up and Flexible Lock–Up Control
The engine control module carries out the lock–up control by controlling the TERMINAL SLU+ of the module according to
the shift position, vehicle speed, throttle opening degree and running conditions. The engine control module also steadily
keeps applying the lock–up clutch a delicate slippage to improve the transmission efficiency (Fuel efficiency) of the torque
converter.
6. Stop Light SW Circuit
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) when driving in lock–up condition, a signal is input to TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module. The engine control module operates and cuts the current to the solenoid to release lock–up.
7. AI–Shift Control
The engine control module judges whether the road is downslope or upslope by detecting the throttle opening degree or the
vehicle’s speed. Moreover it can expect the winding roads by detecting the turning condition of the vehicle. The engine
control module keeps unnecessary shifting up from the fourth gear from operating and carries out the automatic shifting
down to the third gear in order to control the vehicle running according to the road conditions. The engine control module
also reads the driver’s intention during driving from his (her) accelerating operation and the running conditions of the vehicle.
As a result of that, ideal shifting patters for each driver are automatically selected without any switching operations.
244
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A24
Code
36
See Page
J4
See Page
J34
B
38
C8
A
37
38
J35
A
38
C9
B
37
J8
A
38
J36
B
38
C10
C
37
J9
B
38
C11
D
37
J10
A
38
J50
D
38
D1
37
J11
B
38
J51
E
38
E1
34 (1GR–FE)
J18
38
J52
F
38
M1
A
35 (1GR–FE)
E2
J7
Code
38
J37
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J20
38
E4
A
37
J25
38
P1
35 (1GR–FE)
E5
B
37
J27
38
S6
39
E6
C
37
J29
A
38
S12
39
E7
D
37
J30
B
38
S28
35 (1GR–FE)
E8
E
37
J31
A
38
T2
35 (1GR–FE)
J2
A
35 (1GR–FE)
J32
B
38
T4
35 (1GR–FE)
J3
B
35 (1GR–FE)
J33
A
38
V11
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1G
1J
1K
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1L
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IC4
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
45 (1GR–FE)
Front Left Fender
EE
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
EF
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
245
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cruise Control for 2UZ–FE
D1
Data Link Connector 3
(BAT)
10A
ETCS
CANL
TC
6
14
13
P–L
2
CANH
V
20A
EFI
P
(BAT)
2
2
2
C 3C
2 E
LG
13 IC4
L
W–B
12 IC4
8 E
3 E
7 E
P–L
GR
1
L
A B
EFI
Relay
33 D
+BM
TC
SB
6
SLT+
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
IH
246
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R–W
13
SLT–
5
SLU+
SLU–
BR
14
SR
SLU–
14 B
R–B
LG–B
P–L
W–L
B
W
7
S2
B
C A
15
S1
SLU+
15 B
LG
8
SLT–
12 B
L–R
A B
SLT+
13 B
GR
GR
A B
SR
9 B
11 IC4
EB
23 E
CANL
G
S2
10 B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
S1
11 B
B
+B2
2 E
B
+B
1 E
W–B
W–B
B B
34 D
CANH
2
B A
B
BATT
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
W–B
2
B
MREL
2
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
3
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
1 E
P–L
1 F
2
W–G
5
C 3C
E A
35 IC4
2
2 D
W–G
W–G
L
1 D
ST–Plug
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction Connector
L
GR
P–L
H
J18
Junction
Connector
H
(IG)
S6
Transmission
Control SW
15A
IG1
NSSD
9
V
D 3E
A
D 3E
EP1
EP2
6
3
4
1
5
2
W–R
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
34 IC4
31 IC4
26 IC4
9 IC3
29 IC4
8 IC3
7
D
H
V
VCP2
2
A A
A A
Y–R
VCP1
Y–R
VPA2
J20
Junction
Connector
VPA1
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
A
Y–R
H
2 IM1
A
Y–R
W–R
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
A
18 E
19 E
26 E
27 E
20 E
21 E
VPA
VPA2
VCPA
VCP2
EPA
E B
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
J7
Junction
Connector
A24
Accel Position Sensor
V
Y–R
9 IM1
V
8 1J
V
J25
Junction
Connector
21 D
EPA2
D
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VTA1
M–
4 A
GE01
17 A
E2
28 A
EC
EOM
35 D
9 C
1 IM2
G
2
1
M+
M–
BR
R
4
VTA2
VC
A B
A A
A A
W–B
5
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
R
SL2–
(Shielded)
R–B
6
3
SL2+
M+
5 A
VTA1
Y
L
R
11
SL1–
V
4
SL1+
Y
12
VTA2
19 A
W–B
20 A
W–B
VC
23 A
L–R
B–R
SL2–
16 B
B–W
SL2+
17 B
B–Y
SL1–
18 B
G–B
SL1+
19 B
E2
W–B
W–B
A
J37
Junction
Connector
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
W
3
IK
247
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cruise Control for 2UZ–FE
(BAT)
(IG)
10A
STOP
10A
IGN
2
2
23 1E
G–Y
C
B–O
J4
Junction
Connector
3
S12
Stop Light SW
2
C
B–O
B–O
G–W
15 IC3
11 1J
1
4
R–L
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
E 3C
B A
B A
B–O
G–Y
G–Y
E 3C
J4
Junction
Connector
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
H A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B
11 IC3
B B
B
G–Y
R–L
B–O
E B
15 E
16 E
9 E
ST1–
STP
IGSW
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
E04
7 B
E05
6 B
E01
7 A
E02
6 A
E1
1 C
CCS
ME01
3 B
18 D
3 IK1
L–B
V–R
10 IM2
BR
L–B
8 D
BR
BR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
BR
PI
SPD
2 D
4
LG
E03
4 B
5
CCS
ON–OFF
ECC
G B
+ RES
– SET
CANCEL
V–R
C13
Combination SW
G A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
4WD
8 C
LG
V–R
BR
EE
ED
248
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BR
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
2
R
4 1G
J7
Junction
Connector
D
10 IC4
R
R
R–L
D
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
F B
16 C
Speedometer
CRUISE
LG
V–R
5 B
13 C
4 B
GR–R
11 A
BR
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
15 C
1 1G
7 IM1
V–R
11 1K
GR–R
7 IC2
12
SP1
B 3D
BR
LG
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
B 3D
V–R
V–R
BR
249
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cruise Control for 2UZ–FE
System Outline
The cruise control system is a constant vehicle speed controller in which control of the switch on the instrument panel makes
it possible to automatically adjust the opening of the engine throttle valve without depressing of the accel pedal.
1. Set Operation
When the ON–OFF SW is turned on, the system starts preparations necessary for the cruise control and turns on the
indicator light in the combination meter.
2. Set Speed Control
When the – SET SW is operated with the cruise control main SW turned on during travelling, the constant vehicle speed is
controlled.
3. Coast Control
When the – SET SW is kept turned on during cruise control travelling, the engine control module controls the throttle valve to
decelerate the vehicle. Every time the – SET SW is turned on instantaneously, the vehicle speed is decelerated
approximately 1.5 km/h.
4. Accel Control
When the + RES SW is kept turned on during cruise control travelling, the engine control module controls the throttle valve to
accelerate the vehicle. Every time the + RES SW is turned on instantaneously, the vehicle speed is accelerated
approximately 1.5 km/h.
5. Resume Control
When the vehicle speed is above the low speed limit (Approximately 40 km/h, 25 mph) if the cruise control is cancelled, use
of the + RES SW accelerates the vehicle to the speed level used before canceling the cruise control.
6. Manual Cancel Mechanism
If any of the following signals is input during cruise control travelling, the cruise control is cancelled.
∗ The stop light SW is turned on.
∗ The CANCEL SW is turned on.
∗ The ON–OFF SW is turned off.
∗ Gear is shifted from D position to other positions than D.
7. Auto Cancel Operation
∗ If any of the following conditions are detected, the set speed is erased and the control is canceled.
(1) Disconnection and/or short in the stop light SW
(2) Malfunction in the vehicle speed signal
(3) Malfunction in the electronic throttle parts
(4) Malfunction in the stop light SW input circuit
(5) Malfunction in the cancel circuit
(6) The actual vehicle speed becomes –16 km/h slower than the set speed
∗ If the following condition is detected, the set speed is kept and the control is canceled.
(1) The actual vehicle speed becomes slower than the minimum speed limit.
8. Overdrive Control Function
Overdrive is sometimes cut off on gradients during cruise control driving. When end of climbing gradient is determined by
throttle opening degree information after overdrive is canceled, control is reset to overdrive condition after overdrive resetting
timer operation. Also, when overdrive is cut off during accelerator resuming control, control is reset to overdrive condition
when accelerator resuming control is finished.
250
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A24
Code
36
J2
J3
See Page
Code
See Page
A
33 (2UZ–FE)
J32
B
38
B
C8
A
37
33 (2UZ–FE)
J33
A
38
C9
B
37
J4
38
J34
B
38
C10
C
37
J7
38
J37
38
C13
37
J8
A
38
J50
D
38
D1
37
J9
B
38
J51
E
38
E1
32 (2UZ–FE)
J18
38
J52
F
38
E4
A
37
J20
38
P1
33 (2UZ–FE)
E5
B
37
J25
38
S6
39
E6
C
37
J29
A
38
S12
39
E7
D
37
J30
B
38
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
E8
E
37
J31
A
38
T2
33 (2UZ–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1E
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1K
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Upper Side of the Glove Box)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IC4
IK1
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
44 (2UZ–FE)
Front Left Fender
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
EE
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
251
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cruise Control for 1GR–FE
D1
Data Link Connector 3
(BAT)
10A
ETCS
CANL
TC
6
14
13
P–L
2
CANH
V
20A
EFI
P
(BAT)
2
2
2
C 3C
2 E
LG
13 IC4
L
W–B
12 IC4
8 E
3 E
7 E
P–L
GR
1
L
A B
EFI
Relay
33 D
+BM
TC
SB
6
SLT+
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
IH
252
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R–W
13
SLT–
5
SLU+
SLU–
BR
14
SR
SLU–
14 B
R–B
LG–B
P–L
W–L
B
W
7
S2
B
C A
15
S1
SLU+
15 B
LG
8
SLT–
12 B
L–R
A B
SLT+
13 B
GR
GR
A B
SR
9 B
11 IC4
EB
23 E
CANL
G
S2
10 B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
S1
11 B
B
+B2
2 E
B
+B
1 E
W–B
W–B
B B
34 D
CANH
2
B A
B
BATT
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
W–B
2
B
MREL
2
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
3
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
1 E
P–L
1 F
2
W–G
5
C 3C
E A
35 IC4
2
2 D
W–G
W–G
L
1 D
ST–Plug
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction Connector
L
GR
P–L
H
J18
Junction
Connector
H
(IG)
S6
Transmission
Control SW
15A
IG1
NSSD
9
V
D 3E
A
D 3E
EP1
EP2
6
3
4
1
5
2
W–R
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
34 IC4
31 IC4
26 IC4
9 IC3
29 IC4
8 IC3
7
D
H
V
VCP2
2
A A
A A
Y–R
VCP1
Y–R
VPA2
J20
Junction
Connector
VPA1
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
A
Y–R
H
2 IM1
A
Y–R
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
19 E
26 E
27 E
20 E
21 E
VPA
VPA2
VCPA
VCP2
EPA
J25
Junction
Connector
V
W–R
A
18 E
E B
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
J7
Junction
Connector
A24
Accel Position Sensor
V
Y–R
9 IM1
V
8 1J
21 D
EPA2
D
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VC
VTA1
VTA2
20 A
19 A
M+
M–
5 A
4 A
GE01
17 A
E2
28 A
EOM
35 D
SL2–
W–B
BR
(Shielded)
A B
R
3
SL2+
5
VC
6
4
2
1
VTA1
VTA2
M+
M–
A A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
L
B–R
11
SL1–
V
4
SL1+
Y
12
R
B–W
B–Y
G–B
L–R
23 A
L
SL2–
16 B
P
SL2+
17 B
G–W
SL1–
18 B
G–B
SL1+
19 B
W
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
W–B
E2
3
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
J37
Junction
Connector
A
IK
253
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cruise Control for 1GR–FE
(BAT)
(IG)
10A
STOP
10A
IGN
2
2
B–O
G–Y
G–W
15 IC3
B–O
J4
Junction
Connector
3
S12
Stop Light SW
2
C
C
11 1J
B–O
23 1E
1
4
R–L
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
E 3C
B A
B A
B–O
G–Y
G–Y
E 3C
J4
Junction
Connector
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
H A
B
11 IC3
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B B
B
G–Y
R–L
B–O
E B
15 E
16 E
9 E
ST1–
STP
IGSW
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
E03
4 B
E04
7 B
E05
6 B
ME01
3 B
E01
7 A
E02
6 A
CCS
E1
PI
SPD
2 D
1 C
8 D
18 D
J28
Junction
Connector
10 IM2
3 IK1
BR
L–B
E
5
ECC
CCS
EF
EE
254
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
+ RES
G A
LG
– SET
V–R
C13
Combination SW
ON–OFF
G B
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
4
LG
V–R
L–B
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
E
CANCEL
V–R
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
2
R
4 1G
J7
Junction
Connector
D
10 IC4
R
R
R–L
D
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
F B
16 C
Speedometer
13 C
4 B
GR–R
5 B
BR
7 IC2
1 1G
7 IM1
11 1K
GR–R
LG
11 A
V–R
CRUISE
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
15 C
V–R
12
SP1
B 3D
BR
LG
B 3D
V–R
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
V–R
EE
255
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cruise Control for 1GR–FE
System Outline
The cruise control system is a constant vehicle speed controller in which control of the switch on the instrument panel makes
it possible to automatically adjust the opening of the engine throttle valve without depressing of the accel pedal.
1. Set Operation
When the ON–OFF SW is turned on, the system starts preparations necessary for the cruise control and turns on the
indicator light in the combination meter.
2. Set Speed Control
When the – SET SW is operated with the cruise control main SW turned on during travelling, the constant vehicle speed is
controlled.
3. Coast Control
When the – SET SW is kept turned on during cruise control travelling, the engine control module controls the throttle valve to
decelerate the vehicle. Every time the – SET SW is turned on instantaneously, the vehicle speed is decelerated
approximately 1.5 km/h.
4. Accel Control
When the + RES SW is kept turned on during cruise control travelling, the engine control module controls the throttle valve to
accelerate the vehicle. Every time the + RES SW is turned on instantaneously, the vehicle speed is accelerated
approximately 1.5 km/h.
5. Resume Control
When the vehicle speed is above the low speed limit (Approximately 40 km/h, 25 mph) if the cruise control is cancelled, use
of the + RES SW accelerates the vehicle to the speed level used before canceling the cruise control.
6. Manual Cancel Mechanism
If any of the following signals is input during cruise control travelling, the cruise control is cancelled.
∗ The stop light SW is turned on.
∗ The CANCEL SW is turned on.
∗ The ON–OFF SW is turned off.
∗ Gear is shifted from D position to other positions than D.
7. Auto Cancel Operation
∗ If any of the following conditions are detected, the set speed is erased and the control is canceled.
(1) Disconnection and/or short in the stop light SW
(2) Malfunction in the vehicle speed signal
(3) Malfunction in the electronic throttle parts
(4) Malfunction in the stop light SW input circuit
(5) Malfunction in the cancel circuit
(6) The actual vehicle speed becomes –16 km/h slower than the set speed
∗ If the following condition is detected, the set speed is kept and the control is canceled.
(1) The actual vehicle speed becomes slower than the minimum speed limit.
8. Overdrive Control Function
Overdrive is sometimes cut off on gradients during cruise control driving. When end of climbing gradient is determined by
throttle opening degree information after overdrive is canceled, control is reset to overdrive condition after overdrive resetting
timer operation. Also, when overdrive is cut off during accelerator resuming control, control is reset to overdrive condition
when accelerator resuming control is finished.
256
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A24
36
Code
J3
See Page
B
Code
35 (1GR–FE)
J33
J34
See Page
A
38
B
38
C8
A
37
J4
38
C9
B
37
J7
38
C10
C
37
J8
A
38
J50
D
38
C13
37
J9
B
38
J51
E
38
D1
37
J18
38
J52
F
38
E1
34 (1GR–FE)
J20
38
J37
38
P1
35 (1GR–FE)
E4
A
37
J25
38
S6
39
E5
B
37
J28
38
S12
39
E6
C
37
J29
A
38
S28
35 (1GR–FE)
E7
D
37
J30
B
38
T2
35 (1GR–FE)
E8
E
37
J31
A
38
J2
A
35 (1GR–FE)
J32
B
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1E
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1K
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Upper Side of the Glove Box)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IC4
IK1
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
45 (1GR–FE)
Front Left Fender
EE
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
EF
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
257
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, DAC and HAC
(BAT)
(BAT)
(IG)
30A
ABS SOL
40A
ABS MTR
2
2
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE 4WD
: w/ Electric Modulated Air Suspension
: w/o Electric Modulated Air Suspension
1
J4
Junction
Connector
G
R
L
P
B–O
L–O
9
Y
FRO
Y–B
FLO
8
Y–B
C
2 A
2 B
31 A
18 A
4 A
3 A
17 A
1 B
38 A
+BM1
FL+
+BS
+BM2
FL–
FR+
FR–
37 A
FLO
IG2
S15
Suspension
Control ECU
C
2
(∗3)
2
1
2
3
4
L–R
1
∗
∗
∗
∗
B–O
Y–B
A10
ABS Speed Sensor
Front RH
23 1E
A9
ABS Speed Sensor
Front LH
2
(∗3)
2
10A
IGN
FRO
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
RL–
PKB
GND3
LBL
41 A
4 B
28 A
GND1
1 A
W–B
A B
A A
A A
6 BC2
3 BC2
4 BE1
3 BE1
2
2
B
W
(∗4)
W–B
(∗4)
B
W–B
A41
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear RH
A40
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear LH
W
1
P4
Parking Brake SW
1 BE1
W–B
LG
W–B
1
2 BE1
1
1
W–B
EA
EB
BO
258
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(∗1)
LG
A B
2
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction Connector
B B
W–B
W
B
(∗4)
(Shielded)
V
(∗3)
G
(∗4)
P
(∗3)
(∗4)
R
(∗4)
(Shielded)
B A
W–B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
1 1E
W–B
2 BC2
W–B
1 BC2
2 1E
B14
Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
5 BC2
(∗1)
8 IB2
W–B
V
4 BC2
7 IB2
W
10 IB2
B
9 IB2
P
W–B
LG
19 A
W
RR–
5 A
B
RR+
6 A
V
RL+
20 A
P
GND2
32 A
ADD
H B
24 A
L4
G B
B
20 A
IND2
F 9(A), F10(B)
4WD Control ECU
J28
Junction
Connector
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
A B
W–B
A
II
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R–W
P
6
2
44 A
17 IC2
A
IK
W–B
Y–R
C
8 IM1
A
A
HDCS
3
4
B 3F
A
J25
Junction
Connector
Y–R
H A
H A
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
Y–R
(2WD)
A
E
J7
Junction
Connector
E
D5
Downhill Assist
Control SW
B
A A
B
A
A B
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
9
R–W
EXI
C
J35
Junction
Connector
2
Y–R
15A
IG1
(2WD)
13 IC2
W–B
G–B
Y–R
(2WD)
T3
Transfer Shift
Actuator
G–B
G–B
G–B
E A
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
C A
(4WD)
27 A
E
A
(4WD)
C A
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
E
W–B
F A
1 IC2
W–G
STPO
W–G
G–B
1
W–B
E A
J1
Junction
Connector
(4WD)
3
G–B
E
W–B
12 IC2
D
W–B
NEO
R–L
2
(4WD)
A B
R–L
10 A
(4WD)
16 A
R–L
7 A
(4WD)
2
R–L
18 IC3
2
STOP LP CTRL
Relay
4
(4WD)
2 IC2
LG
D
J37
Junction
Connector
18 B
EXI4
1
J24
Junction
Connector
C
LG
2
R–L
21 A
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
STP
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G–W
(4WD)
C
F A
G–R
STP2
(4WD)
45 A
G–R
3
(4WD)
J4
Junction
Connector
G–R
G–B
2
G–B
5
(4WD)
A11
ADD Actuator
J4
Junction
Connector
G–W
2
G–R
W–L
W–B
(4WD)
S12
Stop Light
SW
G–W
10A
STOP
(4WD)
W–L
EXI3
(4WD)
26 A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
16 IM2
W–L
G–Y
B
(4WD)
GR
(∗2)
G–Y
B
W–L
GR
(∗2)
G–Y
2
(4WD)
C
J28
Junction
Connector
6 EC1
GR
(∗1)
(∗2)
ADD
GR
GR
(∗2)
B
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
(BAT)
(IG)
8 1J
20 1E
A
2
2 IM1
Y–R
14 A
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
P
43 A
CSW
6 IC2
CDL
3
A42
Auto LSD SW
11 IM2
4
22 B
W–B
P1
W–B
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
259
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, DAC and HAC
B–R
(IG)
R–Y
R–B
10A
ECU–IG
R–Y
R–B
15 IC2
4 IC2
R–Y
R–B
28 1J
B
D
B–R
12 1E
R–W
B–R
J4
Junction
Connector
B–R
V5
VSC Warning
Buzzer
2
B
R–W
J4
Junction
Connector
F
F
J1
Junction
Connector
F
5 IC2
D
IG1
R–W
46 A
BZ
R–B
B–R
30 A
R–Y
GR–G
1
13 A
24 A
42 A
D/G
TS
WFSE
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
R
V–W
19 IC2
16 IC2
9 IC2
(∗2)
L–W
(∗5)
(∗7)
V–W
L–W
R
14 IM2
13 IM2
HDCW
33 A
(4WD)
VSCW
36 A
20 IC2
7 IC3
Y–R
LG–R
18 IC2
LG–R
B–L
8 IC2
B–L
GR–R
7 IC2
GR–R
B
11 IC2
B
W
22 IC2
W
WT
35 A
BR–Y
15 A
Y–R
INFR
IND
34 A
L–W
WA
29 A
(4WD)
BRL
3 B
(∗6)
SP1
12 A
G–W
CANH
11 A
(2WD)
CANL
25 A
BR–Y(4WD)
Y–R
L–W(∗2)
L–W(∗6)
L–W(∗5)
L–W(∗7)
R
LG–R
B–L
GR–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B
W
260
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B–R
B–R
R–Y
R–Y
R–B
R–B
R–W
R–W
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
1
2
5
6
7
8
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE 4WD
: 2UZ–FE 2WD
: 2UZ–FE 4WD
: 1GR–FE 2WD
: 1GR–FE
(IG)
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
10A
DOME
2
4 1G
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
R
R–L
2
15 C
D
J7
Junction
Connector
BRAKE
D
H A
17 C
20 C
4 D
19 A
4 B
13 C
16 C
BR
GR–R
B–L
LG–R
R
L–W(∗7)
L–W(∗1)
L–W(∗2)
Y–R
BR–Y(4WD)
F B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
ABS
18 C
Slip
VSC TRAC
12 A
VSC OFF (4WD)
AUTO LSD (2WD)
DAC
Speedometer
R
10 IC4
R
BR–Y(4WD)
Y–R
12 IM2
L–W(∗2)
L–W(∗6)
7 IM1
L–W(∗5)
L–W(∗7)
BR
(∗1)
(∗8)
LG–R
BR
R
B–L
GR–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B
B
W
W
EE
ED
261
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, DAC and HAC
B–R
R–Y
R–Y
R–B
R–B
R–W
R–W
R
W
(BAT)
10A
ECU–B
2
W–R
B–R
2
G A
4 1B
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
G A
D A
B 3E
E B
D A
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
W–R
B–R
4 1L
GND
CANL
11
3
1
2
CANL
W
CANH
ESS
2
R
B–R
IG
W–B
B–R
5
IG1
B
1
BAT
Y
W–R
9
W–B
S11
Steering Sensor
B 3E
3
CANH
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
B
W–B
Y
W–B
B
B
W
W
262
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R–Y
R–B
R–W
R
R–Y
W
G A
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
R–W
R–B
R–Y
G A
15
12
7
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
WFSE
TS
CANH
SIL
V
L
LG
CANL
34
P
CANH
33
R
CANL
14
W
6
E7
Engine Control Module
1 B
2 B
1 D
2 D
1 E
2 E
2 C
1 A
2 A
Y
B
W
J47(A), J48(B), J49(C),
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
1 F
W–B
1 C
B
ST–Plug
B
Y
B
W
IH
263
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, DAC and HAC
System Outline
1. Normal Operation
The VSC system helps prevent the vehicle from slipping sideways as a result of strong front wheel skid or strong rear wheel
skid during cornering.
The followings are two possible circumstances in which the tires exceed their lateral grip limit. The VSC system is designed
to help control the vehicle behavior by controlling the engine output and the brake at each wheel when the vehicle is under
one of the conditions indicated below.
∗ When the front wheels lose grip in relation to the rear wheels (Strong front wheel skid tendency).
∗ When the rear wheels lose grip in relation to the front wheels (Strong rear wheel skid tendency).
2. Electronic Brake–Force Distribution
Skid control ECU with actuator distributes appropriate brake–force to front and rear wheels (Control of brake–force
distribution to front and rear wheels) corresponding to the vehicle driving conditions. It also makes effective use of rear wheel
brake–force to match the loading condition and decelerating of the vehicle, resulting in reducing brake pedal depression and
ensuring effective braking. In braking during making a turn, the ECU controls appropriate brake–force distribution to right and
left wheels (Control of brake–force distribution to right and left wheels) to ensure stability and braking of the vehicle.
3. Downhill Assist Control Operation
The downhill assist control operation controls braking action of each wheel to help prevent an out–of–balance posture of the
vehicle when descending a steep hill or traveling at a speed exceeding the threshold of wheel gripping capability. When the
downhill assist control is in operation, the brake system controls vehicle speed within the range of 5 to 7 km/h.
For the downhill assist control to be operative, all of the following conditions have to be met:
∗ Downhill assist control switch = ON
∗ Transfer L4 selected
∗ Vehicle speed is 5 km/h or more, but less than 25 km/h.
∗ Accelerator pedal OFF
∗ Brake pedal OFF
4. Hill–Start Assist Control Operation
When starting on a steep hill for ascending, the hill–start assist control automatically puts the brake on momentarily when the
driver switches from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal, to help the driver start the vehicle safely and smoothly.
Please bear in mind, however, that it activates the brake system only for 3 seconds.
For the hill–start assist control to be operative all of the following conditions have to be met:
∗ Shift position = D, 2, or L
∗ No vehicle move due to wheel slip
∗ Vehicle speed > 0 km/h
5. Active TRAC (4WD)
During rugged off–road driving, this function controls the engine output and the brake fluid pressure that is applied to the
slipping wheel, and distributes the drive force that would have been lost through the slippage to the remaining wheels in
order to achieve a LSD effect.
6. Auto LSD (2WD)
Auto LSD fulfills the function of LSD by using the system of TRAC. It helps ensures to recover from run–off condition and to
take off on roads with much travel resistance such as sand.
264
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
A9
34 (1GR–FE)
32 (2UZ–FE)
A10
Code
See Page
J2
A
J3
B
Code
35 (1GR–FE)
See Page
J35
33 (2UZ–FE)
38
J37
38
35 (1GR–FE)
J47
A
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J4
38
J48
B
38
A11
34 (1GR–FE)
J5
38
J49
C
38
A40
40
J7
38
J50
D
38
A41
40
A42
B14
J8
A
38
J51
E
38
36
J9
B
38
J52
F
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J12
A
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J13
B
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
P1
35 (1GR–FE)
C8
A
37
J14
A
38
P4
39
C9
B
37
J15
B
38
S11
39
C10
C
37
J18
A
38
S12
39
C11
D
37
J20
A
38
S15
39
D1
37
J21
B
38
D5
37
J24
38
E7
37
J25
38
J28
38
S28
A
S29
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
F9
A
37
F10
B
37
J29
A
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
J30
B
38
35 (1GR–FE)
J31
A
38
V5
39
33 (2UZ–FE)
J32
B
38
Y1
39
J1
J2
A
T3
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1E
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1L
3E
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EC1
45 (1GR–FE)
Engine Wire and Differential Wire (Near the Front Differential)
IB2
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
BC2
48
Frame Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Rear LH Seat)
BE1
48
Frame Wire and Skid Control Sensor Wire (Right Side of No.5 Crossmember)
IC2
IC3
IC4
IM1
IM2
265
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, DAC and HAC
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
EE
266
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
267
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
AHC and Electric Modulated Air Suspension
(BAT)
(IG)
D1
Data Link Connector 3
R–W
15 IC2
GR–G
4 IC2
22 BC2
17 BC2
11 BC2
R–Y
G A
F
R–Y
J4
Junction
Connector
5 IC5
D
B
GR–G
R–W
B–R
P–L
R–B
R–Y
18 A
10 C
6 C
5 C
20 C
IG
TC
TS
4
22 A
23 A
21 A
B
BR–Y
2
D
BR–W
AIR SUS
Relay
3
J1
Junction
Connector
1
10A
AIRSUS
NO. 2
4
3
R–Y
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
H A
5 IB2
2
SHG
2
G A
J4
Junction
Connector
5
2
SHRL
R–B
1
4
F
SHB
1
H A
P–L
BR–Y
L–Y
BR–Y
L–Y
SIL
7
P–L
12 1E
B–R
2
TS
12
BR–W
13
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
TC
2
4
H15
Height Control Sensor Rear LH
10A
ECU–IG
R–B
50A
AIR SUS
2
L–B
RC
SIL
SBL2
SHRL
SGL2
S13(A), S14(B), S15(C)
Suspension Control ECU
SLLO
20 BC2
21 BC2
12 BC2
P–G
4
2
1
2
1
W–B
B B
L1
Low Pressure
Tank Valve
H14
Height Control
Motor
P
3
W–B
L–B
P–G
7 A
O
B A
RM–
26 A
L–B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
GR
RM+
25 A
P
6 B
O
B
1 IB1
L–B
W–B
1 BC1
W–B
W–B
EB
268
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(BAT)
(IG)
H16
Height Control Sensor Rear RH
15A
IG1
10A
STOP
SHRR
2
SHG
2
G–W
3
Y–R
20 1E
2
5
S12
Stop Light
SW
GR
W
G–R
2
18 BC2
1
4
STOP
LP CTRL
Relay
3
1
9 BC2
2
Y–R
G–W
2
2
2
19 BC2
2
D
E
D
E
J1
Junction
Connector
SHB
1
2
20 A
SBR2
24 A
SHRR
G–Y
G–Y
G–B
B
B
E
J4
Junction
Connector
LG
G–B
E
LG
GR
W
G–R
Y–R
12 B
19 A
SGR2
STP
S13(A), S14(B), S15(C)
Suspension Control ECU
V
LG
L
L–W
G
13 BC2
15 BC2
10 IC5
9 IC5
11 IC5
V–W
V
LG
L
L–W
G
1
3
1
3
LOSW
2
E
HEIGHT
CONTROL OFF
GND
5
HSW
H12
Height Control
SW
2
3
H13
Height Control
Compressor
H17
Height Control
Valve
V–W
14 BC2
+
MOD2
11 C
6
GND
1 C
MOD1
12 C
GND2
5 B
A B
A B
A B
A A
A A
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
TD
24 B
W–B
DNSW
15 B
W–B
UPSW
16 B
W–B
SLEX
8 A
W–B
SLRR
2 A
H19
Height Control Mode Select SW
SLRL
1 A
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
4
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
BN
J24
Junction
Connector
A
II
EB
269
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
AHC and Electric Modulated Air Suspension
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
DCTY
PCTY
RLCY
RRCY
23
24
11
12
37 IE1
6 IO3
8 C
9 C
FLO
1
P–L
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
LG
1
D13
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
R–G
1
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
R–B
F A
D14
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
12 IC5
P–B
L–R
L–O
LG
H B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
R–G
R–B
ACTY
20
P–L
FRO
37
P–B
FLO
38
R–Y
STPO
16
B5
Body ECU
4 C
FRO
DOOR
S13(A), S14(B), S15(C)
Suspension Control ECU
TACH
E7
Engine Control
Module
VN
LO
NR
HI
BR–B
Y–B
Y
13 IC5
4 IC5
3 IC5
2 IC5
1 IC5
BR–B
Y–B
Y
16 C
Y–G
17 C
Y–G
18 C
B–W
15 C
B–W
13 B
TACH
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B–W
1
F B
B–W
G A
F A
Y
F A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–B
BR–B
Y–G
H B
B–W
270
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
R
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
H A
4 1G
2
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
R–L
R
F B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
16 C
Tachometer
J7
Junction
Connector
R
15 C
R
10 IC4
D
13 C
BR
6 B
B–W
OFF
5 A
Y–G
LO
4 A
BR–B
N
3 A
Y–B
HI
2 A
Y
Height Control
R
D
7 IM1
Y
BR
Y–B
BR–B
Y–G
B–W
ED
271
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
AHC and Electric Modulated Air Suspension
System Outline
∗ The electric modulated suspension with height control is a system designed to maintain a constant vehicle height by
means of an electro–pneumatic system in the rear suspension to cope with change in load such as passenger number
and/or weight of cargo in the vehicle. With the three–height–control switch on the console, the driver can set the vehicle
height from the three different height modes (High, normal and low): ”High mode” for rough terrain and ”Low mode” for
passenger to get on/off, and for cargo to be loaded/unloaded.
∗ This system has five basic controls as shown below:
∗ Auto leveling control
This control maintains a constant rear vehicle height regardless of change in load such as passenger number and/or
weight of cargo in the vehicle.
∗ Vehicle height switchover control
This control switches the height mode to the mode selected with the height control switch.
∗ High mode (+ 40 mm / 1.6 in.)
∗ Low mode ( – 20 mm / 0.8 in.)
∗ Speed sensing control
Regardless of the initial setting of the vehicle height, ”High mode” or ”Low mode,” this control automatically switches the
vehicle height mode to the optimum ”Normal mode” in the following conditions:
∗ When the vehicle speed reaches or exceeds 30 km/h with ”High mode,” or;
∗ When the vehicle speed reaches or exceeds 5 km/h with ”Low mode.”
∗ Subsequent control after ignition switch off
After the ignition switch is turned OFF, this control lowers the rear vehicle height for passengers to get off, etc.
∗ Height control OFF control
If the system is turned OFF with the vehicle height control switch, the vehicle can be jacked up or towed.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
B5
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
36
H14
40
J18
A
38
C8
A
37
H15
40
J19
B
38
C9
B
37
H16
40
C10
C
37
H17
40
J31
A
38
D1
37
H19
37
J32
B
38
D12
40
J1
D13
40
J2
D14
40
J3
D15
40
J4
E7
37
J7
H12
37
J8
A
38
H13
40
J9
B
38
See Page
L1
40
A
33 (2UZ–FE)
S12
39
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
S13
A
39
38
S14
B
39
38
S15
C
39
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
2
22
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
4
23
Engine Room R/B No.4 (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
J24
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1E
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
272
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IB1
IB2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IC2
IC4
IC5
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
48
Frame Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Rear LH Seat)
BC1
BC2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
44 (2UZ–FE)
Front Left Fender
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BN
48
Near the No.5 Crossmember of Side Frame LH
273
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multi Mode 4WD
(IG)
(IG)
W–B
W–B
T3
Transfer Shift Actuator
13 1J
10
J7
Junction
Connector
Y–R
8 1J
W–B
20A
4WD
15A
IG1
6
GND
GND
A
M
M
Y–R
A
HM1
HM2
HL1
HL2
TM1
TM2
TL1
TL2
TL3
V
CDL
7
12
11
2
1
3
4
5
G
L
L–Y
17 B
26 B
2 B
5 B
25 B
L–B
GR
4 B
L–W
R–B
1 B
24 B
23 B
(∗1)
Y
B
L–R
Y–R
H
B
A
R–L
J25
Junction
Connector
8
R–L
H
J28
Junction
Connector
J20
Junction
Connector
9
A
6 A
22 B
IG
P1
HM1
HM2
HL1
HL2
TM1
TM2
TL1
TL2
TL3
Y–R
F 9(A), F10(B)
4WD Control ECU
N
2–4
22 A
LO
8 A
GND
15 A
DL
16 A
1 A
2 IM1
2
2–4
(∗1) (∗1)
GR
(∗2)
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
H4
4
L4
W–B
H2
GND
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
4
A A
W–B
G–W
A B
A B
A A
W–B
W–B
F11
4WD Control SW
3
LO
(∗1)
G–W
(∗2)
D4
Diff. Lock SW
5
W–B
L
GR
C B
C A
10 IM1
II1
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
9
6
II1
(∗1)
L
N
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
2
6
(∗1)
(∗1)
P
Y–R
G–W
L
(∗2)
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
J37
Junction
Connector
W–B
A
A
IK
274
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A
A
IG
J5
Junction
Connector
2 EC1
3 EC1
LG
1 EC1
1
DM1
C
2
DM2
6
DL1
5
DL2
F 9(A), F10(B)
4WD Control ECU
E A
12 B
DL2
H B
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
BR–W
20 A
IND2
11 A
C
4 EC1
5 EC1
M
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G–R
G–R
J20
Junction
Connector
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G B
ED
G–R
DL1
IND1
BR–W
W–B
19 A
(∗1)
13 B
W–B
9 A
(∗1)
W–G
24 A
(∗1)
V–R
G B
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
G A
(∗1)
DM2
P–L
SPD
P–L
6 B
(∗1)
L4
(∗1)
H B
LG
(∗1)
B–W
DM1
(∗1)
3 B
B–W
F A
V–R
G–R
(∗1)
ADD
(∗1)
W–L
W–B
3
W–L
W–L
E6
Engine Control
Module
W–L
L4
(∗2)
6 EC1
(∗1)
R
GR
(∗1)
ADD
R
GR
(∗1)
18 B
W–B
GR
(∗1)
F A
J28
Junction
Connector
W–L
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
W–L
W–B
13
∗ 1 : 1GR–FE
∗ 2 : 2UZ–FE
2 IC2
15 IM2
V–R
W–G
G–R
(∗1)
F A
E
E
IND3
W–B
(∗1)
4
GND
G–R
A11
ADD Actuator
BR–W
EF
275
Multi Mode 4WD
∗ 1 : 1GR–FE
∗ 2 : 2UZ–FE
W–L
(BAT)
10A
DOME
2
R
2
10 IC4
J7
Junction
Connector
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
R
H A
V–R
W–G
D
F B
W–L
(∗1)
D
R
R
21
EXI4
SP1
C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
5 B
V–R
4 B
13 C
BR
12
Speedometer
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
16 C
1 1G
GR–R
7
IC2
GR–R
7 IM1
BR
B 3D
(∗1)
BR
B 3D
(∗2)
V–R
11 1K
V–R
W–G(∗1)
G–R
G–R
BR–W
BR–W
ED
276
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
(IG)
7. 5A
GAUGE
R–L
4 1G
C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
4LO
6 D
7 D
BR–W
(∗1)
W–G
5 D
G–R
(∗1)
4WD
Center Diff.
Lock
(∗1)
15 C
W–G(∗1)
G–R
BR–W
277
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multi Mode 4WD
System Outline
Depending on the transfer shift actuator status and ADD actuator (1GR–FE) status, the 4WD control ECU drives the transfer
shift actuator and ADD actuator (1GR–FE) to electrically change the gear position selected by the driver according to vehicle
speed signal and neutral start switch signal.
1. Shift Select Control
Shifting from H2 into H4 position (1GR–FE)
When the 4WD control switch is turned from H2 into H4, this signal is input into 4WD control ECU (TERMINAL 2–4). Then,
the 4WD control ECU moves the 2–4 select motor (TERMINAL 2, TERMINAL 1) in the transfer shift actuator until the shift
fork shaft shifts to the diff. free position, performing a shift into H4 position
Switching diff. lock ON when in H4 position.
When the diff. lock switch is turned ON with the 4WD control switch in H4 position, this signal is input into the 4WD control
ECU (TERMINAL DL). Then, the 4WD control ECU drives the 2–4 select motor (TERMINAL 2, TERMINAL 1) in the transfer
shift actuator until the shift fork shaft shifts to the diff. lock position, locking it in H4 position with the diff. lock.
Shifting from H4 into L4 position
When the 4WD control switch is turned from H4 into L4, this signal is input into 4WD control ECU (TERMINAL LO). Then, the
4WD control ECU drives the H–L select motor (TERMINAL 8, TERMINAL 7) in the transfer shift actuator, shifting the shift
fork shaft, performing a shift into L4 position.
Switching diff. lock ON when in L4 position.
When the diff. lock switch is turned ON with the 4WD control switch in L4 position, this signal is input into the 4WD control
ECU (TERMINAL DL). Then, the 4WD control ECU drives the 2–4 select motor (TERMINAL 2, TERMINAL 1) in the transfer
shift actuator until the shift fork shaft shifts to the diff. lock position, locking it in L4 position with the diff. lock.
2. Function of Limit Switch
H4L limit switch (TERMINAL 12 and TERMINAL 11 of transfer shift actuator)
The H4L limit switch in the transfer shift actuator feeds back the current shift position status (H4 or L4) information, which is
based on the ON/OFF combination of the two switches, to the 4WD control ECU.
4WD limit switch (TERMINAL 3 (1GR–FE), TERMINAL 4 and TERMINAL 5 of transfer shift actuator)
The 4WD limit switch in the transfer shift actuator feeds back the current shift position status (H2 or H4) (1GR–FE) and diff.
lock or diff. free status information, which is based on the ON/OFF combination of the two (2UZ–FE) or three (1GR–FE)
switches, to the 4WD control ECU.
ADD limit switch (TERMINAL 6 and TERMINAL 5 of ADD actuator) (1GR–FE)
The ADD limit switch in the ADD actuator feeds back the current front diff. lock or free status information, which is based on
the ON/OFF combination of the two switches, to the 4WD control ECU.
3. Shift Limit Control
The 4WD control ECU interrupts the shift select control and gives the driver a warning by means of buzzer (Integrated into
the ECU) sound and blinking indicator light on the combination meter when the following shift change conditions exist.
The warning, however, can be canceled when the 4WD control switch is canceled and the switch position is returned to the
original position before the warning occurred.
∗ Shift change (1GR–FE) from H2 into H4 with vehicle traveling at a speed reaching or exceeding 100 km/h (Buzzer sound
and blinking 4WD and center diff. lock indicator lights)
∗ Shift change from H4 into L4 with vehicle traveling at a speed reaching or exceeding 5 km/h but with the A/T shift position
N range (Buzzer sound and blinking L4 indicator light)
4. ADD Actuator Control (1GR–FE)
When switching over between H2 (2WD) and H4 (4WD), the 4WD control ECU controls the way in which power is supplied
to the ADD motor in the ADD actuator, as shown below, to run the ADD motor in normal or reverse direction, thereby
changing the status of the front diff. from free to lock, or vice versa.
For locking front diff.
For unlocking front diff.
TERMINAL DM1
TERMINAL DM2
TERMINAL DM1
TERMINAL DM2
+B
GROUND
GROUND
+B
278
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A11
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
34 (1GR–FE)
J9
B
38
J32
B
38
C9
B
37
J10
A
38
J33
A
38
C10
C
37
J11
B
38
J34
B
38
C11
D
37
J14
A
38
D4
37
J15
B
38
E6
37
J20
38
A
37
J24
38
B
F9
F10
37
J25
38
F11
37
J28
38
J5
38
J29
A
38
J7
38
J30
B
38
38
J31
A
38
J8
A
J37
P1
S28
T3
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1G
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1K
3D
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EC1
45 (1GR–FE)
Engine Wire and Differential Wire (Near the Front Differential)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IC2
IC4
II1
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
ED
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
EF
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
EE
279
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
280
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
SRS
NOTICE: When inspecting or repairing the SRS, perform service in accordance with the following precautionary instructions
and the procedure, and precautions in the Repair Manual applicable for the model year.
D Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to confirm, so the DTCs become the most important source of information
when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting the SRS, always inspect the DTCs before disconnecting the battery.
D Work must be started more than 90 seconds after the ignition SW is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the
negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back–up power source so that if work is started within 90 seconds from
disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may deploy.)
D When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the memory of the clock and audio system will be
cleared. So before starting work, make a record of the contents in the audio memory system. When work is finished,
reset the audio systems as they were before and adjust the clock. Some vehicles have power tilt steering, power
telescopic steering, power seat and power outside rear view mirror which are all equipped with memory function.
However, it is not possible to make a record of these memory contents. So when the work is finished, it will be
necessary to explain it to your customer, and ask the customer to adjust the features and reset the memory. To avoid
erasing the memory in each system, never use a back–up power supply from outside the vehicle.
D Before repair, remove the airbag sensor if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensor during repair.
D Do not expose the following parts directly to hot air or flame;
D Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS does not deploy, the following parts should be inspected;
D Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace with new parts.
D For the purpose of reuse, never disassemble and repair the following parts.
D If the following parts have been dropped, or have cracks, dents and other defects in their case, bracket, and connector,
replace with new one.
D Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting electrical circuits of the system.
D Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions of the notice.
D After work on the SRS is completed, check the SRS warning light.
D If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the IN section of the Repair
Manual.
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
Steering wheel pad
Front passenger airbag assembly
Side airbag assembly
Curtain shield airbag assembly
Seat belt pretensioner
Center airbag sensor assembly
Front airbag sensor assembly
Side airbag sensor assembly
Rear airbag sensor assembly
281
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
SRS
CSL–
14 A
13 A
VUCL
4 D
18 D
ESCL
CSR+
19 D
CSR–
VUCR
C17
Curtain Shield
Airbag Squib RH
S26
Side Airbag Squib LH
ESCR
9 A
ESCR
10 A
ICL+
7 D
ICR+
12 A
ICR–
(∗1)
Y–G
2
(∗1)
Y–R
(∗1)
(∗1)
8 D
ICL–
1
2
Y–V
Y–O
(∗1)
Y–V
(∗1)
20 D
1
Y–O
2
1
(∗1)
1
(∗1)
4
(∗1)
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
1 A
CSL+
VUCR
GR–R
2
LG–B
CSR–
3
L–W
CSR+
1
(∗1)
ESCL
4
(∗1)
VUCL
2
LG–B
CSL–
3
L–Y
CSL+
15 A
C16
Curtain Shield
Airbag Squib LH
S19
Side Airbag Sensor Rear RH
L–B
S18
Side Airbag Sensor Rear LH
11 A
SFL–
SFL+
PR+
PR–
10 D (∗1)
6 E (∗2)
9 D
5 E
Y
PL–
7 A
1 B
Y–B
PL+
8 A
2 B
Y
E2
28 C
Y–B
P2–
7 C
W–B
Y–O
P2+
8 C
1
2
1
2
Y–P
Y–V
P–
11 C
1 IU1
2 IU1
3 IU1
4 IU1
Y–P
Y–B
P+
10 C
Y–GR
Y
W–B
1 A
2 A
1 B
2 B
IL1
L
2
D2–
Y–GR
17 C
D2+
Y–G
16 C
Y–G
14 C
GSW2
Y–R
D+
13 C
E1
27 C
Y–R
D–
23 C
L
A30(A), A31(B), A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
32
F/PS
2
1
4
Spiral
Cable
3
E7
Engine Control
Module
P16
Pretensioner LH
A36
Airbag Squib
(Steering Wheel Pad)
A48(A), A49(B)
Airbag Squib
(Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly)
IJ
IH
282
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
P17
Pretensioner RH
(IG)
(IG)
∗ 1 : w/ Side Airbag
∗ 2 : w/o Side Airbag
10A
SRS
15A
IG1
B12
Buckle SW LH
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
8 1J
D3
Passenger Seat Belt
Warning Light
1
2
4
H
PAON
P–AB
IG+
13
6
2
H
Y–R
3
L–W
V
R–B
4 A
3 B
3 A (∗1)
8 B (∗2)
Y–R
A
B–O
G–Y
G–R
G–W
A
(∗1)
(∗1)
Y–G
2
Y–R
1
A
Y–R
VS
S27
Side Airbag Squib RH
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
A
GND
6 D
5 D
SFR+
SFR–
J20
Junction
Connector
B–O
Buckle SW
J7
Junction
Connector
Y–R
20 1L
2 A
7 B
5 C
IG2
19 A
11 B
LBE–
LBE+
LSP+
J25
Junction
Connector
25 C
LSP–
1 C
PAON
P–AB
A30(A), A31(B), A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
1
+SR
–SR
4
A15
Airbag Sensor
Front RH
A A
A B
W–B
A14
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
BR–W
2
–SL
ESL
SSR+
16 D
18 A
SSR–
13 D
VUPR
17 D
ESR
15 D
2
4
1
3
2
SSL–
VUPL
ESL
SSR+
SSR–
4
VUPR
GR
(∗1)
P
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
(∗1)
L–Y
(∗1)
GR–L
(∗1)
P–L
(∗1)
LG–B
(∗1)
3
SSL+
1
ESR
(∗1)
B–W
1
+SL
W–B
BR
2
VUPL
16 A
S16
Side Airbag Sensor Front LH
S17
Side Airbag Sensor Front RH
(∗1)
W–R
3
L–W
1 IN2
R25
Roll Sensing of Curtain
Shield Airbag Cutoff SW
2 IN2
SSL–
20 A
(∗1)
B–R
1 IC1
17 A
IL1
B–R
1
2 IC1
SSL+
RMSW
21 C
(∗1)
BR–W
–SR
20 C
B–W
+SR
9 C
BR
–SL
26 C
W–R
+SL
15 C
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
283
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
SRS
∗
∗
∗
∗
(IG)
7. 5A
GAUGE
: w/ Side Airbag
: w/o Side Airbag
: w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
: w/o Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
D1
Data Link Connector 3
R–L
4 1G
1
2
3
4
TC
F
G
H
16 IO3
P–L
R–Y
F
A 3A
C 3C
A 3A
R–Y
R–Y
H
J18
Junction
Connector
G
SRS
P–L
B16(A), (B)
Buckle SW RH
R–Y
13
J35
Junction
Connector
SIL
7
R–Y
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
RSCA OFF
15 C
2 BI1
LA
19 C
SIL
TC
L
P–L
12 C
GR
R–Y
3 C
C 3C
2 A
5 A
9 A
DIA
BGND
BSW
O 3(A), O 4(B)
Occupant Classification ECU
A30(A), A31(B), A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
B
1 BI1
4 BI1
FSR–
FSR+
4 A
8 A
W
W
FSR–
2 D (∗1)
10 E (∗2)
B
FSR+
1 D
3 E
GND
3 A
W–B
RMIL
B–Y
(∗1)
L–Y
A 3A
6 C
2 A (∗3)
2 B (∗4)
1 A
1 B
2 C
V
10 A
W–B
B
W
3 BI1
BM
284
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
IGN
10A
ECU–B
2
B–O
O6
Occupant Classification
Sensor Front RH
4 1B
SGD1
SVC2
SIG2
SGD2
1
2
3
1
2
3
BR
G
W
L
O
B
4 1L
W–R
SIG1
B A
B B
SVC1
7 B
SIG1
1 B
SGD1
12 B
SVC2
8 B
SIG2
SGD2
B–O
1
2
3
SVC4
SIG4
SGD4
O7
Occupant Classification
Sensor Rear LH
O8
Occupant Classification
Sensor Rear RH
BR
6 BI1
B–O
3
SGD3
5 BI1
15 IO3
14 IO3
B–O
2
SIG3
IG
7 A
R
BR
1
SVC3
+B
1 A
W–R
4 B
W–R
10 B
B
SGD4
6 B
V
SIG4
3 B
W
SVC4
9 B
Y
SGD3
5 B
GR
SIG3
B 3E
2 B
O 3(A), O 4(B)
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC3
B 3E
W–R
11 B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B–O
SVC1
R
B
J8
Junction
Connector
O5
Occupant Classification
Sensor Front LH
2
W–R
11 1J
285
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
SRS
System Outline
∗ The system reaches an ignition judgment to deploy the following device based on the signals received from the front
airbag sensor and deceleration sensor.
– Driver Airbag
– Front Passenger Airbag
– Seat Belt Pretensioner
∗ The system reaches an ignition judgment to deploy the following device based on the signals received from the side
airbag sensors.
– Side Airbags
– Curtain Shield Airbags
∗ The dual–stage SRS airbag system has been used for the driver and front passenger airbags. This system controls the
optimal airbag inflation by judging the extent of impact, seat position (driver seat) and whether or not the seat belt is
fastened (driver seat) and information from the front passenger occupant classification system.
∗ The front passenger occupant classification system judges whether the front passenger seat is occupied by an adult or
child (with child seat) or is unoccupied, according to the load applied to the front passenger seat and whether the seat belt
is buckled. Based on the results, it restricts the deployment of the front passenger airbag, front passenger side airbag, and
front passenger seat belt pretensioner. In addition, the system informs the driver of the result of the judgment through the
use of the AIRBAG ON/OFF indicator lights.
∗ A Roll Sensing Curtain Shield Airbag system has been adopted in order to deploy the curtain shield airbags and the
pretensioners, in the event that the vehicle rolls over.
∗ A Roll Sensing Curtain Shield Airbag cutoff SW is provided near the driver side to enable the driver to disable this system.
∗ The airbag sensor assembly transmits a signal to the engine control module in order to stop the fuel pump.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
C17
40
34 (1GR–FE)
D1
37
32 (2UZ–FE)
D3
37
34 (1GR–FE)
E7
37
A
36
J5
38
A31
B
36
J7
38
A32
C
36
J8
38
A33
D
36
J14
A
38
A34
E
36
J15
B
38
P16
41
A14
A15
A30
A36
O5
O6
O7
O8
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
36
J18
38
P17
41
A48
A
36
J20
38
R25
39
A49
B
36
J25
38
S16
41
A
38
S17
41
B
38
S18
41
38
S19
41
B12
42 (*1)
J31
43 (*2)
J32
A
42 (*1)
B
43 (*2)
C8
A
37
C10
C
37
B16
C16
J35
O3
O4
40
A
B
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
* 1 : Power Seat
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
* 2 : Manual Seat
286
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
S26
S27
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1L
3A
3C
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IL1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Upper Side of the Glove Box)
IN2
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IU1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire Assembly (Right Upper Side of the Glove Box)
BI1
50 (*1)
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Front RH Seat)
51 (*2)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IJ
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BM
48
Floor Seat Crossmember RH
* 1 : Power Seat
* 2 : Manual Seat
287
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Moon Roof
B 5(B)
Body ECU
(BAT)
DCTY
30A
POWER
PWS
23 B
(IG)
10A
ECU–IG
21
1 1A
W–B
B–R
6 1A
W–B
3 1A
L–O
15 1A
W–B
11 1A
L
13 1A
8
1
4
10
9
H B
R–B
F A
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
R–B
2 1H
W–B
2
1
E2
PWS
+B
IG
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
E
M5
Moon Roof Control ECU
M+
M
M–
CLOSE
SPD
OPEN
6
5
4
3
UP
SLIDE
V
LG
GR
7
P7
Moon Roof
Control SW
5 1A
1 1G
E
2
W–B
W–B
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
288
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
V–R
∗ 1 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 2 : 1GR–FE
(IG)
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
10A
DOME
2
4 1G
R
2
R
R–L
10 IC4
D
J7
Junction
Connector
R
D
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
F B
16 C
Speedometer
15 C
13 C
4 B
GR–R
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
BR
5 B
GR–R
V–R
7 IC2
7 IM1
12
SP1
ED
BR
(∗2)
BR
(∗1)
V–R
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
EE
289
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Moon Roof
System Outline
Current is always applied from the POWER fuse to TERMINAL 10 of the moon roof control ECU. With the ignition SW turned
on, the current flows to TERMINAL 9 of the moon roof control ECU.
1. Moon Roof Open/Close Operation
For moon roof operation, there are moon roof control switches: ”Slide open/tilt down”; and ”Slide close/tilt up.” When a switch
is pressed and held down for a certain period of time, one touch automatic operation takes place in accordance with the
function of the switch.
2. Key–Off Operation
Roof remains operable – until about 45 seconds elapse after the ignition SW is turned from ON to OFF or until the driver’s
seat door is opened and closed, whichever first occurs.
However, if an overload reverse operation was going on at that time, the key–off operation continues until it comes to an end.
3. Overload Reverse Operation
The moon roof control ECU detects jamming of the moon roof by foreign material, if occurred, from abnormal motor speed
signal and reverses the moon roof operation.
4. Deflector Control Function
When the roof is slid fully open, the moon roof control ECU automatically adjusts the height of deflector in accordance with
the vehicle cruising speed.
∗ When the battery terminal or fuse is disconnected, the roof position has to be reset to its initial position by the moon roof
control SW in accordance with the following procedure:
(1) Reconnect the battery terminal or fuse.
(2) Turn ON the ignition switch.
(3) Operate the moon roof control SW to open the roof halfway or more.
(4) Then operate the moon roof control SW to fully close the roof.
Do not release the switch for at least one second after the roof is fully closed.
: Parts Location
Code
B5
See Page
Code
B
36
C9
B
37
J8
C10
C
37
J9
D12
40
J5
38
See Page
J7
2
See Page
22
41
A
38
P7
41
B
38
J18
A
38
J19
B
38
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1A
1G
1H
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IC2
IC4
IM1
See Page
See Page
M5
: Relay Blocks
Code
Code
38
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
290
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Ground Points
Code
ED
EE
IG
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
46
Left Kick Panel
291
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Shift Lock
(ACC)
(BAT)
(IG)
7. 5A
ACC
10A
ECU–IG
10A
STOP
2
8 1K
28 1J
B–R
G–W
2
2
E 3C
S12
Stop Light SW
G
J20
Junction
Connector
G–Y
15 IC3
B
B–R
1
G–Y
P
G
E 3C
F 3E
G–Y
6
7
ACC
STP
D
IG
1
B–R
W–B
E
8
L–W
KLS+
A 3D
IJ1
L–W
1
B
S6
Shift Lock Control ECU
12
B–R
A 3D
K3
Key Interlock
Solenoid
4
B 3F
3
J15
Junction
Connector
W–B
B
3F
A
W–B
B 3F
J5
Junction
Connector
A
A
IG
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
D
B–R
P
G–Y
F 3E
J4
Junction
Connector
J37
Junction
Connector
A
IK
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
292
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J12
Junction
Connector
System Outline
When the ignition SW is turned to ACC position the current from the ACC fuse flows to TERMINAL 6 of the shift lock control
ECU. When the ignition SW is turned to ON position, the current from the ECU–IG fuse flows to TERMINAL 1 of the shift lock
control ECU.
1. Shift Lock Mechanism
If the brake pedal is depressed with the ignition SW set at ON (The stop light SW is on), the shift lock control ECU is
activated, allowing the driver to change the shift lever to a position other than the P position.
2. Key Interlock Mechanism
With the ignition SW at ON or ACC position, when the shift lever is put in P position, the current flowing from TERMINAL 12
of the shift lock control ECU to key interlock solenoid is cut off. This causes the key interlock solenoid to turn off (Lock lever
disengages from LOCK position) and the ignition key can be turned from ACC to LOCK position.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J4
38
J20
38
S6
39
S12
39
J5
38
J24
38
J12
38
J37
38
J15
38
K3
39
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1J
1K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
3C
3D
3E
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IJ1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
293
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Remote Control Mirror
(ACC)
(BAT)
7. 5A
ACC
20A
EFI
2
F 3E
8 1K
F 3E
2
P
P
L
38 IC4
GR
P
2
2
17 IA1
C
L–W
R24
Remote Control Mirror SW
3
ACC CUT
Relay
C
8
Operation SW
Y–B
M+
E
6
7
C
B
2
2
W–G
GR
30 IC4
16 IC3
W–G
3
W–B
4
1
GR
Select SW
Right
/Down
Left
/Up
Down
VR
2
Y–B
VL
5
L–Y
HR
4
RH
P–B
LH
G–R
RH
P–G
HL
Up
Left
Right
B
LH
2
J6
Junction
Connector
J38
Junction
Connector
C
L–Y
G–R
L–R
W–B
15 IA1
14 IA1
16 IA1
4 IA2
LG–R
Y–B
B
LG–B
C
16 IP1
15 IP1
17 IP1
2
3
1
3
2
1
MH
MV
M+
MV
MH
M+
M
M
M
ACCR
E8
Engine
Control
Module
W–B
L–R
G–R
L–Y
Y–B
P–B
P–G
17
M
A
J5
Junction
Connector
M3
Remote Control Mirror LH
M4
Remote Control Mirror RH
IG
294
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
E8
37
J38
40
J5
38
M3
41
J6
38
M4
41
Code
R24
See Page
41
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1K
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
3E
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA1
IA2
IC3
IC4
IP1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
IG
See Page
46
Ground Points Location
Left Kick Panel
295
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
B
(ACC)
(BAT)
7. 5A
ACC
(BAT)
20A
EFI
15A
A/F HEATER
2
2
8 1K
L
ACC
P
AM1
2
2
IG1
F 3E
B–R
W–G
L
F 3E
B–R
I18
Ignition SW
P
2
1
2
3
3
2
L
3
2
2
2
B
2
2
B
GR–B
B
B
W–B
2
W
W–G
GR
R
2
1
2
2
2
5
C/OPN Relay
5
B
5
1
GR–B
1
2
2
B–W
4
2
B
2
2
EFI Relay
3
2
A/F HEATER Relay
2
ACC CUT Relay
L
P
38 IC4
B–W
B
B–R
R
ST2
B–O
W–G
IG2 6
L
7 AM2
2
2
33 IC4
GR–B
10A EFI NO. 2
W–B
30A AM2
9 IC4
11 IC4
B
1
2
2
1
L–W
2
2
A
J4
Junction
Connector
4 IM1
B B
A
L–W
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
L–W
Battery
B A
1 IB2
17 IC3
GR–B
B
L–W
W–B
W
B
A
L–W
W
W–G
EB
70
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
GR–B
L–W
19 IM2
M
5
A B
BO
2 IB1
B A
B A
B–O
B–R
FC
+B
9 E
30 C
10 E
1 E
B B
B A
A B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2 E
+B2
17 E
ACCR
A B
A B
C A
16 IC3
B–Y
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
N
STA Relay
P
A
A
3 E
8 E
8 B
11 C
MREL
STAR/
NSW
26 A
AIV2
2
1
J28
Junction
Connector
B–Y
B–O
P
B–Y
L
V13
VSV (Air Switching Valve Bank 2)
L–W
FPR
W–G
C
P
35 IC4
B
A
W–G
W–G
B
6 1D
12 IC4
B–R
L
IGSW
8
EA1
V12
VSV (Air Switching Valve Bank 1)
L–W
11 1J
GR–B
BATT
W–G
B–W
L
B–R
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
23 1E
G–R
C
L
B–R
B–R
B
4
W–G
1
10A
IGN
B–O
2
B–O
B–O
B–W
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B–O
2
B–O
2
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
B–O
5
F14
Fuel Pump
5 IC4
B–R
2
W–B
4
J4
Junction
Connector
3
W–B
W–B
B–R
2
B–R
FUEL PUMP Relay
1
B–Y
G–R
2
F8
Fuel Pump
Resistor
G–R
2
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
G–R
B
B
4
EB1
B–R
5
4
STA
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
27 A
AIV1
2
1
B
L–W
L–W
L–W
L–W
W
W
W–G
L–W
BL
71
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
B
B
B–R
B–R
B–R
1
2
2
I14
Injector No. 6
2
2
2
2
L
W
Y
G
R
W
BR
A
A
J26
Junction
Connector
R–L
2
I16
Injector No. 8
B–R
1
I15
Injector No. 7
B–R
1
I13
Injector No. 5
1
I12
Injector No. 4
1
I11
Injector No. 3
1
I10
Injector No. 2
1
I9
Injector No. 1
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
1
2
R–L
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
Combination Meter
B–R
3 C
4 C
5 C
6 C
7 C
3 A
2 A
R–L
A
2 C
# 10
# 20
# 30
# 40
# 50
# 60
# 70
# 80
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VPMP
5 E
AIP
PPMP
22 E
32 A
W–L
Canister
Pressure Sensor
R
R–G
O
L4
Canister Pump Module
1 EB2
W–L
Leak
Detection Pump
Vent Valve
M
3
8
9
2
AIP
1
6
2
4
E2
16 IM2
22 IM2
7 IM2
VC
L–R
3
BR
L–R
42 IE1
L–R
BR
43 IE1
BR
W–B
9 IE1
W–B
O
28 IE1
O
11 IE1
L–W
R–G
17 IE1
R–G
R
R
1
A45
Air Pressure Sensor
MPMP
6 E
4 EB2
3 EB2
L–R
BR
L–W
L–W
L–W
L–R
W–B
L–W
W
W
L–W
BR
ED
72
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B
B
∗ 1 : Shielded
(ST)
7. 5A
STA
NO. 2
A24
Accel Position Sensor
L–Y
12 C
STSW
OC2–
R–B
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
2
34 IC4
31 IC4
26 IC4
9 IC3
29 IC4
8 IC3
V–W
L–Y
14 C
OC2+
EP2
5
LG–B
Y–R
15 C
OC1–
EP1
1
W–L
R–W
16 C
OC1+
VCP2
4
B–Y
LG
17 C
VCP1
3
R–B
P
6 IM2
VPA2
6
W–R
1
VPA1
W–R
1
2
C3
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve RH
2
C2
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve LH
2 1K
18 E
19 E
26 E
27 E
20 E
21 E
VPA
VPA2
VCPA
VCP2
EPA
EPA2
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VC
VTA1
VTA2
20 A
19 A
M+
M–
5 A
4 A
GE01
VG
THW
17 A
21 A
30 A
E2G
29 A
THA
22 A
G
2
1
VTA1
VTA2
M+
M–
2
3 B
2 B
4 B
R
Y–B
R
4
B–W
R–B
6
W–R
Y
L–R
(∗1)
L–R
R–L
L–R
23 A
THA
E2
+B
5 B
1 B
L–W
1
E2G
BR
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
M 1(B)
Mass Air
Flow Meter
E2
3
W
BR
VC
VG
E2
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
L–R
5
BR
BR
BR
BR
L–R
L–R
L–W
BR
BR
L–W
L–W
D
L–W
J28
Junction
Connector
C
C
12
IM1
C
L–R
W
L–W
D
W
BR
73
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C
C
BR
W
1 B
1 B
D
C
3
4
AF+
AF–
2
+B
C
C
1
HT
D
HA2A
A1A+
22 B
30 B
2 B
3
4
AF+
AF–
2
+B
W–B
1
HT
L–R
E
J28
Junction
Connector
J26
Junction
Connector
W
74
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G
G–W
3
IGT5
A1A–
E
IGT6
HA1A
BR
J28
Junction
Connector
E
E
E
E
33 B
OX2B
5 B
3
OX
1
HT
2
+B
4
E1
BR
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
IGT4
P
A2A–
3
W
B–L
3
(∗1)
L–Y
R–W
R–Y
R–W
R–Y
R–Y
2
2
2
2
2
2
I7
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 7
I6
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
I5
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
I4
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
I3
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
R–W
BR
31 B
R–L
L–W
R–W
2
I2
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
R–Y
I1
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
R–Y
A12
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A2A+
BR
IGT3
Y
IGT2
(∗1)
LG–B
3
L–W
2 B
23 B
B–W
LG
3
A13
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
E2
L
IGT1
P
R–Y
3
W
1 B
W
28 A
BR
ACIS
(∗1)
33 A
R
PRG
BR
2 B
V 1(B)
VSV (ACIS)
34 A
Y–R
IGF1
L–W
L–W
V 2(B)
VSV (Purge)
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
B
B
∗ 1 : Shielded
R–Y
R–W
R–W
3
24 A
8 A
15 A
11 A
10 A
13 A
12 A
14 A
IGT7
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
HT2B
BR
E
(∗1)
W–B
L–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
L–W
L–W
B
B
(BAT)
(BAT)
10A
ETCS
A32
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
R–W
T8
Transponder Key
Computer
10A
STOP
2
2
2
2
E 3C
2
G–Y
15 IC3
B
B
9 A
25 A
IGT8
IGF2
F/PS
IMO
IMI
G–Y
7 E
15 D
16 D
32 D
E B
G–Y
GR
L
G–B
J4
Junction
Connector
IL1
R–W
2
1
L–R
W–R
13 IC4
3
H A
E 3C
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
2
G–Y
7
G–W
EFII
6
S12
Stop Light SW
EFIO
GR
GSW2
23
L
I8
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 8
R–W
G–Y
15 E
+BM
STP
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
L
NE+
21 C
Y
G
NE–
20 C
(∗1)
R
L
VV2–
28 C
3
2 B
1 B
2 B
C 4(B)
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
1 B
W–B
1
V 4(B)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
2
2
V 3(B)
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
4
VV2+
18 C
(∗1)
24 C
W–B
C1
Camshaft Position
Sensor
+B
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
E1
L–W
HT
BR
OX
VV1–
25 C
(∗1)
W
1
29 C
B
G–Y
3
VV1+
G2–
19 C
Y
G2+
HT1B
1 A
B
(∗1)
OX1B
18 A
2 B
1 B
L–R
BR
(∗1)
W–B
L–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
L–W
ED
75
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
B
B
∗ 1 : Shielded
(BAT)
(BAT)
2
50A
J/B
10A
TAIL
140A
ALT
1
2
2
30A
DEFOG
2
5
L–W
5 1L
1
G
2
DEFOG
Relay
2
Y–G
B
J16
Junction
Connector
1 1C
3
B
2
18 IC4
13 D
12 D
E B
B–R
D B
Y–G
D 3D
Y–G
I B
3
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
I A
G
2
D A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
D 3D
G
G
5
TAIL Relay
1
2
Y–G
D A
ELS2
ELS1
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
6 B
L–B
7 B
E05
W–B
E04
W–B
1 IK1
E03
4 B
W–B
2 IK1
E02
6 A
W–B
8 C
E01
7 A
W–B
24 D
E1
1 C
W–B
4WD
W–B
AC1
W–B
ACT
25 D
(4WD)
THWO
14 D
W–B
EKNK
28 B
(4WD)
KNK1
29 B
GR–G
EKN2
20 B
BR–W
KNK2
21 B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
R
G
(∗1)
B
W
(∗1)
H B
L–B
E A
W–B
7 A
K 2(B)
Knock Sensor
(Bank 2)
K1
Knock Sensor
(Bank 1)
1
2 B
1 B
TWI
2
GR–G
R
C 3D
BR–W
7 EB1
L–B
6 EB1
G
B
3 EB1
(∗1)
8 EB1
BR
2 EB1
W
(∗1)
BR
C 3D
18 A
7 B
ACT
AC1
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
EE
76
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
B
(BAT)
F9
4WD Control ECU
50A
A/PUMP
L4
2
24
2
W–L
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
(4WD)
LG
L
P–L
P–L
H B
E A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
G
V
Y
(4WD)
W–L
F A
14 IC3
4 IC3
A B
5 IM2
4 E
13 E
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
4 B
5 B
1 A
W
30 D
SIP
SIV
VP
+B
BATT
VV
2 A
E
1 B
BR
6 B
L
V–R
TACH
1 D
3 B
DI
R–B
SPD
8 D
B–W
EOM
35 D
W–B
BR
EC
9 C
W–B
ME01
3 B
2 B
AIDI
G
AIRV
A43(A), A44(B)
Air Injection Control Driver
AIRP
R
V
25 E
TC
B
Y
23 E
CANH
G
G
33 D
CANL
Y
P–L
34 D
L4
V
L
13 C
LG
W–L
(4WD)
10 IC3
3 EA1
4 EA1
4 IN1
L
BR
W–B
1
2
W–B
1
A47
Air Switching Valve
M
W–B
A A
2
A46
Air Pump
A A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
A B
G
1 IM2
BR
R–B
B–W
A
ED
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
W–B
BR
V–R
EQ
77
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
(BAT)
7. 5A
OBD
2
2
LG
L
O
P–L
C 3C
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
32 IC4
CANH
H
P
V
L
LG
1 D
2 D
1 E
2 E
E A
2 C
1 A
2 A
11 IC2
22 IC2
3
11
11
25
CANL
CANH
CANL
CANH
SP1
9 IM2
1 F
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
12
W–B
BR
BR
S11
Steering Sensor
J47(A), J48(B), J49(C),
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
W–B
1 C
W
E A
ST–Plug
W
W–B
BR
E B
2 B
B
CG
4
A A
1 B
B
SG
5
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
6
CANH
BR
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
BR
CANL
R
14
BAT
Y
V
16
TC
J22(A)
Junction
Connector
O
13
2
P
P–L
H
CANL
W
3
B
J18
Junction
Connector
P–L
C 3C
GR–R
GR–R
R–B
R–B
B–W
B–W
V–R
V–R
A
ED
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
IH
78
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G A
F B
R–B
6 B
7 IC2
G A
G B
BR
V–R
Tachometer
R
F B
5 B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BR
F A
V–R
Speedometer
R
R
J7
Junction
Connector
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
7. 5A
GAUGE
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction Connector
V–R
H B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
B–W
R–L
H A
V–R
B–W
4 B
GR–R
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
15 C
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
GR–R
B–W
GR–R
7 A
R–B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
R
2
4 1G
2
D
D
10 IC4
16 C
13 C
1 1G
11 1K
7 IM1
B 3D
B 3D
B–W
V–R
ED
79
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
System Outline
The engine control system utilizes a microcomputer and maintains overall control of the engine, transmission etc. An outline
of the engine control is given here.
1. Input Signals
(1) Engine coolant temp. signal circuit
The engine coolant temp. sensor detects the engine coolant temp. and has a built–in thermistor with a resistance which
varies according to the engine coolant temp. The engine coolant temp. is input into TERMINAL THW of the engine
control module as a control signal.
(2) Intake air temp. signal circuit
The intake air temp. sensor is installed in the mass air flow meter and detects the intake air temp., which is input as a
control signal to TERMINAL THA of the engine control module.
(3) Oxygen sensor signal circuit
The oxygen density in the exhaust emission is detected and is input as a control signal from the heated oxygen sensors
to TERMINALS OX1B and OX2B of the engine control module.
(4) RPM signal circuit
The camshaft position is detected by the camshaft position sensor and is input into TERMINAL G2+ of the engine
control module as a control signal. Also, the engine RPM is detected by the crankshaft position sensor and the signal is
input into TERMINAL NE+ of the engine control module.
(5) Throttle position sensor signal circuit
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve opening angle as a control signal, which is input into TERMINALS
VTA1 and VTA2 of the engine control module.
(6) Vehicle speed circuit
The vehicle speed sensor detects the vehicle speed, and the signal is input into TERMINAL SPD of the engine control
module via the combination meter, from TERMINAL SP1 of the skid control ECU with actuator.
(7) Battery signal circuit
Voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL BATT of the engine control module. When the ignition SW is turned on, the
voltage for engine control module start up power supply is applied through the EFI relay, to TERMINALS +B and +B2 of
the engine control module. The current from the IGN fuse flows to TERMINAL IGSW of the engine control module, and
voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL +BM.
(8) Intake air volume signal circuit
The intake air volume is detected by the mass air flow meter, and is input as a control signal to TERMINAL VG of the
engine control module.
(9) Stop light SW signal circuit
The stop light SW is used to detect whether the vehicle is braking or not, and the signal is input into TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module as a control signal.
(10) Starter signal circuit
To confirm whether the engine is cranking, the voltage applied to the starter motor when the engine is cranking is
detected, and is input into TERMINAL STA of the engine control module as a control signal.
(11) Engine knock signal circuit
Engine knocking is detected by the knock sensors, and is input into TERMINALS KNK1 and KNK2 of the engine control
module as a control signal.
(12) A/C SW signal system
The operating voltage of the A/C magnetic clutch is detected and input in the form of a control signal to TERMINAL AC1
of the engine control module.
(13) Air fuel ratio signal system
The air fuel ratio is detected by air fuel ratio sensor and input as a control signal into TERMINALS A1A+ and A2A+ of
engine control module.
80
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2. Control System
∗ SFI system
The SFI system monitors the engine condition through the signals input from each sensors to the engine control module.
The control signal is sent to the engine control module TERMINALS #10, #20, #30, #40, #50, #60, #70 and #80 to operate
the injector (Fuel injection). The SFI system controls the fuel injection by the engine control module in response to the
driving conditions.
∗ ESA system
The ESA system monitors the engine condition through the signals input from each sensors to the engine control module.
The best ignition timing is decided according to this data and the data memorized in the engine control module. The
control signal is output to TERMINALS IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5, IGT6, IGT7 and IGT8, and these signals control the
igniter to provide the best ignition timing.
∗ Heated oxygen sensor heater control system
The heated oxygen sensor heater control system turns the heater on when the intake air volume is low (Temp. of exhaust
emission is low), and warms up the heated oxygen sensors to improve their detection performance. The engine control
module evaluates the signals from each sensors, and outputs current to TERMINAL HT1B or HT2B to control the heater.
∗ Air fuel ratio sensor heater control system
The air fuel ratio sensor heater control system turns the heater on when the intake air volume is low (Temp. of exhaust
emission is low), and warms up the air fuel ratio sensor to improve detection performance of the sensor.
The engine control module evaluates the signals from each sensor, current is output to TERMINALS HA1A and HA2A,
controlling the heater.
∗ Fuel pump control system
The engine control module supplies current to TERMINAL FPR, and controls the operation speed of the fuel pump with
the FUEL PUMP relay.
∗ ACIS
The ACIS includes a valve in the bulkhead separating the surge tank into two parts. This valve is opened and closed in
accordance with the driving conditions to control the intake manifold length in two stages, for increased engine output in all
ranges from low to high speeds.
∗ ETCS–i
The ETCS–i controls the engine output at its optimal level in accordance with the opening of the accelerator pedal, under
all driving conditions.
∗ Engine start control system
The engine control module allows power to be supplied from the TERMINAL STAR/NSW to the STA relay via park/neutral
position SW until complete combustion is confirmed by engine RPM after the detection of ignition SW ST signal by the
TERMINAL STSW.
With this arrangement, engine can be started without holding the ignition key in the ST position. At the same time, the
TERMINAL ACCR is controlled so that the engine control module turns off ACC CUT relay, shutting off power to the
accessories.
∗ VVT–i
Controls the intake camshaft to an optimal valve timing in accordance with the engine condition.
∗ Air Injection System
It is the system to improve exhaust control performance by activating catalyst at early stage, which is realized when air is
pressed and sent into the exhaust pipe forcibly by the air injection pump at starting engine in cold condition.
3. Diagnosis System
When there is a malfunction in the engine control module signal system, the malfunctioning system is recorded in the
memory. The malfunctioning system can be found by reading the code displayed on the malfunction indicator lamp.
4. Fail–Safe System
When a malfunction has occurred in any system, there is a possibility of causing engine trouble due to continued control
based on that system. In that case, the fail–safe system either controls the system using the data (Standard values)
recorded in the engine control module memory, or else stops the engine.
81
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 2UZ–FE
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A12
A13
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
I3
33 (2UZ–FE)
J33
A
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
I4
33 (2UZ–FE)
J34
B
38
A16
A
36
I5
33 (2UZ–FE)
J35
A
38
A17
B
36
I6
33 (2UZ–FE)
J36
B
38
A24
36
I7
33 (2UZ–FE)
A32
36
I8
33 (2UZ–FE)
J40
A
40
A
32 (2UZ–FE)
I9
33 (2UZ–FE)
J41
B
40
B
A43
A44
J37
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
I10
33 (2UZ–FE)
J47
A
38
A45
32 (2UZ–FE)
I11
33 (2UZ–FE)
J48
B
38
A46
32 (2UZ–FE)
I12
33 (2UZ–FE)
J49
C
38
A47
32 (2UZ–FE)
I13
33 (2UZ–FE)
J50
D
38
C1
32 (2UZ–FE)
I14
33 (2UZ–FE)
J51
E
38
C2
32 (2UZ–FE)
I15
33 (2UZ–FE)
J52
F
38
C3
32 (2UZ–FE)
I16
33 (2UZ–FE)
37
K2
33 (2UZ–FE)
C4
B
32 (2UZ–FE)
C8
A
37
J2
A
33 (2UZ–FE)
C9
B
37
J3
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
C10
C
37
J4
38
P1
33 (2UZ–FE)
D1
37
J5
38
S11
39
E2
32 (2UZ–FE)
J7
38
S12
39
A
38
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
E4
I18
K1
B
L4
M1
33 (2UZ–FE)
40
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
A
37
J8
E5
B
37
J9
38
T2
E6
C
37
J16
38
T8
E7
D
37
J18
38
V1
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
E8
E
37
J22
A
38
V2
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
F8
32 (2UZ–FE)
J23
B
38
V3
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
F9
37
J26
38
V4
B
33 (2UZ–FE)
F14
40
J28
38
V12
33 (2UZ–FE)
H6
32 (2UZ–FE)
J29
A
38
V13
33 (2UZ–FE)
H8
32 (2UZ–FE)
J30
B
38
Y1
39
I1
33 (2UZ–FE)
J31
A
38
I2
33 (2UZ–FE)
J32
B
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
1D
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1E
1G
1J
1K
1L
3C
3D
3E
82
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
39
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
44 (2UZ–FE)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Wire (Near the Starter)
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IK1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Upper Side of the Glove Box)
IL1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Upper Side of the Glove Box)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
EB1
EB2
IB1
IB2
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC3
IC4
IM1
IM2
IN1
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
44 (2UZ–FE)
Front Left Fender
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
EE
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
EQ
44 (2UZ–FE)
Near the Starter
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
83
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Cigarette Lighter
(ACC)
10A
CIG
P–L
17 1L
P–L
6 IR1
2
C6
Cigarette
Lighter
W–B
1
W–B
5 IR1
B 3F
W–B
B 3F
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
296
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
C6
37
Code
J24
See Page
Code
See Page
38
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1L
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
3F
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IR1
See Page
47
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cigarette Lighter Wiring Assembly (Rear Console)
: Ground Points
Code
II
See Page
46
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace RH
297
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Outlet for 12V
(ACC)
(BAT)
15A
PWR
OUTLET
7. 5A
ACC
1
3
DC SKT
Relay
2
5
2 1H
31 1J
BR–R
W–B
30 1J
BR–R
BR–R
27 IE1
2
2
P6
Power Outlet
(Front)
1
P8
Power Outlet
(Rear)
A A
A A
B 3F
A
IG
W–B
W–B
W–B
A B
J5
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
W–B
B 3F
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
1
J24
Junction
Connector
II
298
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BL
BO
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J5
38
J40
A
40
P6
39
J24
38
J41
B
40
P8
41
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1H
1J
3F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IE1
See Page
46
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
299
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Outlet for 115V
(IG)
(BAT)
15A
AC115V
INV
15A
IG1
2
E
Y–R
C
E
A
V
Y–R
A
J1
Junction
Connector
2
2
C
2
5
Y–R
Y–R
AC115V
INV Relay
1
3
V
2
H
41 IC4
21 IC4
L
H
V–R
V–R
6
IG
1
4
LG
14 IE1
15 IE1
1 IS1
2 IS1
A A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
LG
R–W
L
AC2
7
LG
4
AC1
3
R–W
IN
3
W–B
E
GND
R–W
M2
Main SW
V9
Voltage
Inverter
IG
W–B
Y–R
16 IE1
1
A B
P5
Power Outlet
(115V)
A B
4
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
J20
Junction
Connector
L
2
W–B
J7
Junction
Connector
20 1E
Y–R
2
8 1J
A B
A A
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
BO
300
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BL
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
J1
Code
33 (2UZ–FE)
J14
35 (1GR–FE)
J15
J5
38
J7
38
See Page
B
38
M2
39
38
P5
39
40
V9
41
A
J41
See Page
38
J20
J40
Code
A
B
40
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1E
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IS1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Console Box Wire (Rear Console)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
301
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Automatic Glare–Resistant EC Mirror with Compass
(IG)
15A
IG1
Y
2 1A
7
I19
Inner
Mirror
W–B
6
14 1A
W–B
2 1H
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
302
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
I19
Code
40
J5
See Page
Code
See Page
38
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
IG
See Page
46
Ground Points Location
Left Kick Panel
303
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Horn
(BAT)
10A
HORN
2
W–G
2
10 1E
1
5
HORN
Relay
3
13 1K
1 1D
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
GR–B
G–R
2
C A
GR–B
1
G–R
6
Horn SW
1
H9
Horn (High)
B B
C13
Combination SW
304
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
H10
Horn (Low)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
C13
Code
37
H10
32 (2UZ–FE)
H9
34 (1GR–FE)
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
J14
Code
J15
See Page
B
38
34 (1GR–FE)
A
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1D
1E
1K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
305
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Electric Tension Reducer
∗ 1 : w/ Driving Position Memory
∗ 2 : w/o Driving Position Memory
(IG)
15A
IG1
J20
Junction Connector
8 1J
H
Y–R
Y–R
H
A
A
A
Y–R
Y–R
5 IE1
A
Y–R
J7
Junction
Connector
A
J25
Junction
Connector
Y–R
Y–R
7 IO3
1
1
T12
Tension Reducer
Solenoid LH
2
V
(∗2)
V
(∗1)
V
2
T13
Tension Reducer
Solenoid RH
F A
F A
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
12 BK1
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
I B
G
G
(∗2)
G
(∗1)
I B
5
5
B15
Buckle SW LH
B17
Buckle SW RH
4
(∗2)
J53
Junction
Connector
W–B
(∗1)
B
A B
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
(∗1)
B
W–B
4
W–B
W–B
A B
A A
A A
W–B
(∗2)
W–B
1 BK1
W–B
(∗1)
BL
BM
306
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
42 (*1)
B15
43 (*2)
J43
42 (*1)
B17
43 (*2)
J7
38
J20
38
See Page
J25
38
A
J44
B
J45
A
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
Code
See Page
J45
A
J46
B
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
J53
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
T12
41
42 (*1)
T13
41
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1J
See Page
25
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BM
48
Floor Seat Crossmember RH
* 1 : Power Seat
* 2 : Manual Seat
307
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Seat for Driver’s Seat with Memory
(BAT)
(IG)
(IG)
15A
IG1
10A
ECU–B
10A
ECU–IG
2
2
Y–R
B–R
W–R
8 1F
8 1J
4 1B
A
J7
Junction
Connector
A
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
J39
Junction
Connector
F
2 BK1
8 BK1
5 BK1
6 BK1
Y
GR
O
W
2
3 B
7 B
4 B
8 B
P
IG
Y–R
2 IM1
G–B
Y–R
6
P
34 IE1
W–R
C
A
35 IE1
B–R
G–B
J25
Junction
Connector
G–B
J18
Junction
Connector
8 IM1
F
E
C
A
E
G–B
E
R–B
C
G–B
Y–R
H
J8
Junction
Connector
W–R
E
J35
Junction
Connector
G–B
J20
Junction
Connector
B–R
C
H
R–B
Y–R
G–B
12 1F
DCTY
SYSB
P27(A), P28(B)
Position Control ECU and SW
FRV–
4 A
G
FRV+
6 A
B
J18
Junction
Connector
Y
F
SLD–
3 A
L
R–B
SLD+
2 A
2
D12
Door
Courtesy SW
Front LH
M
1
308
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
M
1
P20
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Front Vertical Control)
1
P24
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat Slide Control)
R–B
F
(BAT)
30A
D P/SEAT
R–L
29 1J
W–B
4
E
24 IE1
S30
Seat Memory SW
M1
M2
P
V
6 IE1
8 IE1
7 IE1
P
V
9 BK1
LG
LG
3
LG
2
R–L
MRY
1
A
LG
15 BK1
17 BK1
J53
Junction
Connector
A
16 BK1
V
LG
2 B
6 B
5 A
+B
2
P27(A), P28(B)
Position Control ECU and SW
W–B
2
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
E A
Hold
W–B
Release
W–B
V
B
4
1
J53
Junction
Connector
B
W–B
2
B
M
D B
L3
Lumbar Support
Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
1
1 BK1
W–B
M
B
1
3
GND
1 A
P21
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat Lifter Control)
1
LFT–
9 A
W
LFT+
7 A
P23
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat Reclining Control)
P
RCL–
10 A
BR
RCL+
8 A
5
BL
M
2
L5
Lumbar Support
Control Motor
(Driver' s Seat)
W–B
SW2
Y
SW1
W
MMRY
W–B
P
5 B
LG
LG
A
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
309
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Seat for Driver’s Seat with Memory
System Outline
∗ In the power seat system, the position control ECU and SW receives the operation signal from the power seat control
switch via infrared communication to operate each power seat motor and adjust the seat position.
∗ In the event that malfunction occurs during infrared communication, this system has a fail–safe function to only slide or
recline the seat.
∗ This system has the following function:
∗ Manual slide operation
∗ Manual reclining control
∗ Manual front vertical control
∗ Manual rear vertical operation
∗ Driving position memory function
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
D12
40
J35
38
P20
42 (*1)
J5
38
J39
40
P21
42 (*1)
J7
38
J53
42 (*1)
P23
42 (*1)
J8
38
42 (*1)
P24
J18
38
J20
38
J22
A
38
J23
B
38
J25
L3
L5
P1
38
P27
A
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
P28
B
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
* 1 : Power Seat
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
* 2 : Manual Seat
310
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
S30
39
Memo
311
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
P24
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Slide Control)
M
1
1
2
M
1
M
2
312
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
7
1
M
2
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
2
V
Reclining
P21
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Lifter Control)
BR
3
(∗1)
5
P
10
(∗1)
Front
Vertical
P23
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Reclining Control)
G
Slide
(∗1)
Down
Up
Rear
Front
Down
1
P20
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Front Vertical Control)
2
(∗1)
6
Up
Rear
Front
LG
(∗1)
B B
B
9
(∗1)
Y
(∗1)
L
R–L
R–L
Power Seat for Driver’s Seat without Memory
(BAT)
30A
D P/SEAT
29 1J
24 IE1
C A
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
B B
LG
LG
P18
Power Seat Control SW (Driver' s Seat)
4
Lifter
8
W–B
(∗1)
∗ 1 : w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
W–B
LG
Hold
Release
W–B
W–B
A B
A B
4
L5
Lumbar Support Control Motor
(Driver' s Seat)
Y
W–B
(∗1)
W–B
A B
1
W
2
(∗1)
L3
Lumbar Support Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
5
3
1
M
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
2
W–B
A A
BL
313
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Seat for Driver’s Seat without Memory
: Parts Location
Code
J43
See Page
A
J44
Code
42 (*1)
L3
43 (*2)
L5
42 (*1)
B
L3
See Page
1J
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
P23
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
P24
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
P18
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
P20
42 (*1)
See Page
25
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IE1
See Page
46
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
BL
See Page
48
* 1 : Power Seat
See Page
P21
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
Code
43 (*2)
Ground Points Location
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
* 2 : Manual Seat
314
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
315
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Power Seat for Front Passenger’s Seat
(BAT)
30A
P P/SEAT
G–R
32 1J
G–R
2 IO3
C A
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
LG
B B
1
BR
4
W–B
2
1
M
2
3
P
6
Y
Reclining
9
L
Slide
Rear
Rear
Front
Front
P19
Power Seat Control SW
(Front Passenger' s Seat)
1
P26
Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger' s Seat
Slide Control)
M
2
P25
Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger' s Seat
Reclining Control)
A B
W–B
A A
BM
316
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
J45
A
J46
B
42 (*1)
Code
J46
See Page
B
43 (*2)
43 (*2)
P19
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
P25
42 (*1)
Code
P26
See Page
42 (*1)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1J
See Page
25
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IO3
See Page
47
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
BM
See Page
48
* 1 : Power Seat
Ground Points Location
Floor Seat Crossmember RH
* 2 : Manual Seat
317
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Seat Heater
Y–R
(BAT)
(IG)
W–B
20 1E
2
S4
Seat Heater SW LH
2
3
A
IG
C
A
2
V
Y
13 IE1
12 IE1
H
14 BK1
A
R
BR
B
(∗2)
BR
LG
(∗1)
2
5
1
LG
24 IC4
G B
R
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
J25
Junction Connector
(∗1)
H B
2
(∗2)
A
Y
H A
13 BK1
A
(∗1)
Y
(∗2)
V
(∗2)
V
Y–R
Y–R
G A
25A
SEAT
HEATER
J3
Junction
Connector
4
H
1
B
SW
2
Y–R
2
Y–R
W–B
2
J20
Junction
Connector
Y–R
RV
3
(∗1)
2
E
1
E
Y–R
C
J7
Junction
Connector
5
IG Relay
1
B–Y
E
J1
Junction
Connector
Y–R
Y–R
8 1J
W–B
15A
IG1
140A
ALT
S24
Seat Heater LH
F 3C
4
6
(∗1)
W–B
(∗2)
W–B
B
(∗2)
B
C B
J53
Junction
Connector
10 IE1
B
9 IO3
(∗1)
LG
F 3C
LG
F 3C
A B
(∗1)
A A
(∗1)
W–B
1 BK1
(∗2)
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
LG
B A
W–B
7 BK1
(∗2)
LG
(∗1)
(∗2)
LG
LG
W–B
B
LG
EB
BL
318
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
∗ 1 : w/ Driving Position Memory
∗ 2 : w/o Driving Position Memory
Y–R
3
1
IG
E
RV
SW
H B
G B
5
W–B
H A
W–B
L
G A
R
R
8 IO3
BR
18 IO3
1
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
S25
Seat Heater RH
B A
A A
W–B
A B
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction Connector
C B
W–B
LG
W–B
6
B
4
W–B
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction Connector
L
4
R
2
S5
Seat Heater SW RH
Y–R
W–B
LG
A
BM
J24
Junction
Connector
II
A
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
319
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Seat Heater
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
33 (2UZ–FE)
J1
35 (1GR–FE)
J43
33 (2UZ–FE)
J3
35 (1GR–FE)
J7
38
J20
38
J24
38
J25
38
See Page
J37
J44
38
A
B
J45
A
J46
B
2
See Page
22
J53
42 (*1)
S4
39
42 (*1)
S5
39
43 (*2)
S24
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
S25
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1E
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
3C
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
: Ground Points
Code
EB
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BM
48
Floor Seat Crossmember RH
* 1 : Power Seat
43 (*2)
43 (*2)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
B
42 (*1)
: Relay Blocks
Code
Code
J46
* 2 : Manual Seat
320
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
321
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
(ACC)
(BAT)
7. 5A
ACC
(BAT)
20A
EFI
15A
A/F HEATER
2
2
8 1K
L
ACC
P
AM1
2
2
IG1
F 3E
B–R
W–G
L
F 3E
B–R
I18
Ignition SW
P
2
5
1
2
3
3
2
2
L
3
2
2
2
B
2
2
B
GR–B
B
B
W–B
2
W
W–G
GR
R
1
2
2
2
5
C/OPN Relay
5
1
GR–B
1
2
2
B–W
4
2
B
2
2
EFI Relay
3
2
A/F HEATER Relay
2
ACC CUT Relay
L
P
38 IC4
B–W
B
B–R
R
ST2
B–O
W–G
IG2 6
L
7 AM2
2
2
33 IC4
GR–B
10A EFI NO. 2
W–B
30A AM2
9 IC4
11 IC4
B
1
2
2
1
L–W
2
2
A
J4
Junction
Connector
4 IM1
B B
A
L–W
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
L–W
Battery
B A
1 IB2
17 IC3
GR–B
B
L–W
W–B
W
B
A
L–W
W
W–G
EB
84
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
M
1
5
19 IM2
A B
BO
A B
W–G
2 IB1
B A
B A
12 IC4
35 IC4
3 E
8 E
8 B
11 C
MREL
STAR/
NSW
11 1J
B–O
B–R
9 E
IGSW
30 C
FPR
10 E
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
FC
17 E
B B
B A
16 IC3
B
B–O
N
STA Relay
P
B
B
ACCR
1 E
+B
J27
Junction
Connector
B–Y
L
B–Y
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
W–G
B
B–Y
W–G
B–R
C A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
23 1E
W–G
C
P
BATT
GR–B
10A
IGN
Y–B
C
W–G
2
B–O
B
L
3 1H
L
B–R
5 IM1
B
4
6 1D
B–O
2
B–R
B–W
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B–O
B–O
B–W
B–O
2
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
B–O
5
F14
Fuel Pump
5 IC4
B–R
2
W–B
4
J4
Junction
Connector
3
W–B
W–B
B–R
2
B–R
FUEL PUMP Relay
1
B–Y
Y–B
2
F8
Fuel Pump
Resistor
Y–B
2
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–B
B–R
B–R
5
4
STA
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
2 E
+B2
A B
A B
GR–B
B
L–W
L–W
L–W
L–W
W
W
W–G
BL
85
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
(ST)
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
7. 5A
STA
NO. 2
B–R
B–R
2
1
1
1
1
L–Y
1
R–L
R–L
1
I14
Injector No. 6
B–R
2
I13
Injector No. 5
B–R
2
I12
Injector No. 4
B–R
2
I11
Injector No. 3
B–R
2
I10
Injector No. 2
B–R
2
I9
Injector No. 1
G
Y
L
L–Y
J27
Junction
Connector
D
D
R
4 IM2
B
Combination Meter
2 1K
3 C
4 C
5 C
6 C
7 C
12 C
R–L
D
2 C
# 10
# 20
# 30
# 40
# 50
STSW
# 60
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
MPMP
VPMP
6 E
5 E
PPMP
22 E
R
R–G
O
L4
Canister Pump Module
Canister
Pressure Sensor
Leak
Detection Pump
L–R
28 IE1
9 IE1
43 IE1
42 IE1
L–R
11 IE1
BR
17 IE1
W–B
BR
4
W–B
2
O
6
O
1
R–G
9
R–G
R
8
R
3
L–W
Vent Valve
M
17 IM2
22 IM2
7 IM2
L–W
L–W
L–R
W–B
L–W
W
W
BR
EF
86
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
∗ 1 : Shielded
B–Y
W–L
LG–B
V–W
2
R–B
EP2
5
W–R
EP1
1
34 IC4
31 IC4
26 IC4
9 IC3
29 IC4
8 IC3
V–W
14 C
OC2+
VCP2
4
LG–B
15 C
OC1–
VCP1
3
W–L
L–R
16 C
OC1+
VPA2
6
B–Y
L–W
17 C
VPA1
R–B
L–B
1
G–Y
1
2
W–R
2
C2
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve LH
C3
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve RH
A24
Accel Position Sensor
18 E
19 E
26 E
27 E
20 E
21 E
VPA
OC2–
VPA2
VCPA
VCP2
EPA
EPA2
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
G–W
VTA2
19 A
M+
M–
5 A
4 A
GE01
VG
THW
17 A
21 A
30 A
E2G
29 A
THA
22 A
L
B–L
R–Y
R–W
R–B
4
2
1
2
3 A
2 A
4 A
VTA2
M+
M–
(∗1)
6
VTA1
R
L–R
P
L–R
L–R
VTA1
20 A
G–B
VC
23 A
BR
W
E2
+B
5 A
1 A
BR
BR
BR
THA
L–W
1
3
E2G
BR
M 1(A)
Mass Air
Flow Meter
E2
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
VG
BR
VC
E2
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
5
L–R
L–W
12
IM1
L–W
L–R
W
W
BR
L–W
87
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L–W
L–W
1 A
2
+B
BR
A
W
A
A
31 B
1 B
3
4
AF+
AF–
1
HT
A1A+
22 B
30 B
2 B
3
4
AF+
AF–
2
+B
E
W–R
W–R
W–R
W–R
W–R
2
2
2
2
2
IGT4
1
HT
L–W
88
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I6
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
I5
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
I4
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
I3
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
W–R
8 A
9 A
10 A
11 A
12 A
IGT5
13 A
IGT6
24 A
A1A–
HA1A
BR
E
E
J28
Junction
Connector
E
L–R
L–W
33 B
OX2B
5 B
3
OX
1
HT
2
+B
4
E1
BR
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
L
3
L
GR
3
B
HA2A
W–R
(∗1)
A2A–
R–L
IGT3
A12
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
IGT2
L
LG–B
3
P
3
(∗1)
LG
W–R
W–R
BR
2 A
23 B
B–W
P–L
2
I2
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
W–R
I1
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
W–R
L–W
2 A
A2A+
A13
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
E2
BR
PRG
Y
IGT1
W
BR
Y–R
3
W
28 A
G–Y
ACIS
(∗1)
34 A
W–L
33 A
BR
V 2(A)
VSV (Purge)
1 A
L–W
L–W
V 1(A)
VSV (ACIS)
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
∗ 1 : Shielded
W–R
3
IGF1
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
HT2B
BR
E
(∗1)
BR
L–R
J27
Junction
Connector
W
L–W
(BAT)
(BAT)
10A
STOP
10A
ETCS
A32
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
2
2
T8
Transponder Key
Computer
2
2
G–W
G–Y
GSW2
EFIO
EFII
23
6
7
E 3C
E 3C
G–Y
B
GR
32 D
16 D
F/PS
IMI
15 D
15 IC3
E B
B
G–Y
J4
Junction
Connector
IL1
L
2
L–R
W–R
1
13 IC4
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
H A
G–Y
L
GR
S12
Stop Light SW
2
G–Y
7 E
15 E
+BM
IMO
STP
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VV2+
18 C
NE–
VV2–
28 C
BR
21 C
2 A
BR
1 A
3 A
C 4(A)
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
3 A
L
2 A
Y
G
1 A
V 3(A)
VVT Sensor LH (Bank 2)
+B
2
R
HT
V 4(A)
VVT Sensor RH (Bank 1)
E1
4
1
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
OX
L–W
3
NE+
20 C
B
VV1–
29 C
W
VV1+
19 C
(∗1)
G
HT1B
1 A
W
(∗1)
OX1B
18 A
BR
2 A
1 A
L–R
(∗1)
L–R
BR
BR
BR
L–R
BR
BR
L–W
EE
89
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
∗ 1 : Shielded
2
(BAT)
(BAT)
1
50A
J/B
10A
TAIL
140A
ALT
30A
DEFOG
2
2
2
1
3
2
DEFOG Relay
5 1L
5
Y–G
L–W
G
2
B
J16
Junction
Connector
1 1C
18 IC4
Y–G
B
5
Y–G
G
TAIL Relay
D 3D
I A
D A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
D 3D
2
D
B–R
D
1
J22
Junction
Connector
G
2
3
D B
G
Y–G
I B
12 D
13 D
ELS1
ELS2
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
E04
E05
BR–W
GR–G
BR
H B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
W
B
(∗1)
(∗1)
G
R
(∗1)
L–B
W–B
6 B
W–B
7 B
W–B
ME01
3 B
W–B
E03
4 B
W–B
E02
6 A
W–B
E01
7 A
W–B
E1
1 C
W–B
AC1
24 D
BR
ACT
25 D
BR
THWO
14 D
BR
EKNK
28 B
BR
KNK1
29 B
BR
KNK2
21 B
BR
EKN2
20 B
2 IK1
1 IK1
BR
L–B
E A
C 3D
1 ED1
2 ED1
5 ED1
7 A
1 A
K1
Knock Sensor
(Bank 1)
K 2(A)
Knock Sensor
(Bank 2)
TWI
1
GR–G
2
2 A
BR–W
L–B
W
B
C 3D
(∗1)
BR
4 ED1
G
R
(∗1)
6 ED1
18 A
7 B
ACT
AC1
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
EE
90
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EF
F 9(A), F10(B)
4WD Control ECU
(BAT)
A11
ADD Actuator
24 A
7. 5A
OBD
ADD
ADD
L4
18 B
3
GR
GR
(4WD)
(4WD)
W–L
2
LG
L
6 EC1
P–L
C
C
O
V
P
C 3C
E A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
32 IC4
C 3C
P–L
C
(4WD)
W–L
F A
GR
J28
Junction
Connector
H B
(4WD)
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
(4WD)
2
LG
L
P–L
GR
(4WD)
W–L
(4WD)
34 D
33 D
23 E
J18
Junction
Connector
A B
15 IM2
H
35 D
SPD
8 D
14
TACH
1 D
BAT
BR
R–B
B–W
V–R
W–B
CANH
W
SG
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
6
CANL
30 D
5
G–W
P
16
TC
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
CG
TAC
4
9
E
A B
9 IM2
B–W
EOM
PSW
13
TC
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
10 C
V
CANH
W–B
CANL
O
4WD
J22
Junction
Connector
E
1
W–B
BR
A A
B–W
W–B
R–B
B–W
A
A
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
W–B
V–R
BR
P2
Power Steering
Oil Pressure SW
L4
8 C
P–L
H
13 C
EE
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
91
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
LG
L
V
P
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH
CANL
R
P
V
L
LG
2
W
3
1 B
2 B
1 D
2 D
1 E
2 E
ST–Plug
W
11 IC2
22 IC2
W
3
11
11
25
CANL
CANH
CANL
CANH
SP1
S11
Steering Sensor
1 F
W–B
B
2 A
B
1 A
Y
2 C
B
1 C
J47(A), J48(B), J49(C),
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
12
GR–R
GR–R
B–W
B–W
R–B
R–B
B–W
B–W
V–R
V–R
IH
92
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
7 IC2
GR–R
F B
R–B
V–R
6 B
H B
1 1G
G A
G B
BR
V–R
Tachometer
Speedometer
R
R
R
J7
Junction
Connector
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
H A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction Connector
V–R
B–W
R–L
7. 5A
GAUGE
F B
5 B
BR
G A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
F A
V–R
F A
B–W
GR–R
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
15 C
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
B–W
B–W
4 B
B–W
GR–R
7 A
R–B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
R
2
4 1G
2
D
D
10 IC4
16 C
13 C
11 1K
7 IM1
B 3D
B 3D
B–W
V–R
EE
93
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
System Outline
The engine control system utilizes a microcomputer and maintains overall control of the engine, transmission etc. An outline
of the engine control is given here.
1. Input Signals
(1) Engine coolant temp. signal circuit
The engine coolant temp. sensor detects the engine coolant temp. and has a built–in thermistor with a resistance which
varies according to the engine coolant temp. The engine coolant temp. is input into TERMINAL THW of the engine
control module as a control signal.
(2) Intake air temp. signal circuit
The intake air temp. sensor is installed in the mass air flow meter and detects the intake air temp., which is input as a
control signal to TERMINAL THA of the engine control module.
(3) Oxygen sensor signal circuit
The oxygen density in the exhaust emission is detected and is input as a control signal from the heated oxygen sensors
to TERMINALS OX1B and OX2B of the engine control module.
(4) RPM signal circuit
The camshaft position is detected by the VVT sensor (Bank 1) and (Bank 2), and is input into TERMINALS VV1+ and
VV2+ of the engine control module as a control signal. Also, the engine RPM is detected by the crankshaft position
sensor and the signal is input into TERMINAL NE+ of the engine control module.
(5) Throttle position sensor signal circuit
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve opening angle as a control signal, which is input into TERMINALS
VTA1 and VTA2 of the engine control module.
(6) Vehicle speed circuit
The vehicle speed sensor detects the vehicle speed, and the signal is input into TERMINAL SPD of the engine control
module via the combination meter, from TERMINAL SP1 of the skid control ECU with actuator.
(7) Battery signal circuit
Voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL BATT of the engine control module. When the ignition SW is turned on, the
voltage for engine control module start up power supply is applied through the EFI relay, to TERMINALS +B and +B2 of
the engine control module. The current from the IGN fuse flows to TERMINAL IGSW of the engine control module, and
voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL +BM.
(8) Intake air volume signal circuit
The intake air volume is detected by the mass air flow meter, and is input as a control signal to TERMINAL VG of the
engine control module.
(9) Stop light SW signal circuit
The stop light SW is used to detect whether the vehicle is braking or not, and the signal is input into TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module as a control signal.
(10) Starter signal circuit
To confirm whether the engine is cranking, the voltage applied to the starter motor when the engine is cranking is
detected, and is input into TERMINAL STA of the engine control module as a control signal.
(11) Engine knock signal circuit
Engine knocking is detected by the knock sensors, and is input into TERMINALS KNK1 and KNK2 of the engine control
module as a control signal.
(12) A/C SW signal system
The operating voltage of the A/C magnetic clutch is detected and input in the form of a control signal to TERMINAL AC1
of the engine control module.
(13) Air fuel ratio signal circuit
The air fuel ratio is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINALS A1A+ and A2A+ of the engine control
module.
94
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2. Control System
∗ SFI system
The SFI system monitors the engine condition through the signals input from each sensors to the engine control module.
The control signal is sent to the engine control module TERMINALS #10, #20, #30, #40, #50 and #60 to operate the
injector (Fuel injection). The SFI system controls the fuel injection by the engine control module in response to the driving
conditions.
∗ ESA system
The ESA system monitors the engine condition through the signals input from each sensors to the engine control module.
The best ignition timing is decided according to this data and the data memorized in the engine control module. The
control signal is output to TERMINALS IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5 and IGT6, and these signals control the igniter to
provide the best ignition timing.
∗ Heated oxygen sensor heater control system
The heated oxygen sensor heater control system turns the heater on when the intake air volume is low (Temp. of exhaust
emission is low), and warms up the heated oxygen sensors to improve their detection performance. The engine control
module evaluates the signals from each sensors, and outputs current to TERMINAL HT1B or HT2B to control the heater.
∗ Air fuel ratio sensor heater control system
The air fuel ratio sensor heater control system turns the heater on when the intake air volume is low (Temp. of exhaust
emission is low), and warms up the air fuel ratio sensor to improve detection performance of the sensor.
The engine control module evaluates the signals from each sensor, current is output to TERMINALS HA1A and HA2A,
controlling the heater.
∗ Fuel pump control system
The engine control module supplies current to TERMINAL FPR, and controls the operation speed of the fuel pump with
the FUEL PUMP relay.
∗ ACIS
The ACIS includes a valve in the bulkhead separating the surge tank into two parts. This valve is opened and closed in
accordance with the driving conditions to control the intake manifold length in two stages, for increased engine output in all
ranges from low to high speeds.
∗ ETCS–i
The ETCS–i controls the engine output at its optimal level in accordance with the opening of the accelerator pedal, under
all driving conditions.
∗ Engine start control system
The engine control module allows power to be supplied from the TERMINAL STAR/NSW to the STA relay via park/neutral
position SW until complete combustion is confirmed by engine RPM after the detection of ignition SW ST signal by the
TERMINAL STSW.
With this arrangement, engine can be started without holding the ignition key in the ST position. At the same time, the
TERMINAL ACCR is controlled so that the engine control module turns off ACC CUT relay, shutting off power to the
accessories.
∗ VVT–i
Controls the intake camshaft to an optimal valve timing in accordance with the engine condition.
3. Diagnosis System
When there is a malfunction in the engine control module signal system, the malfunctioning system is recorded in the
memory. The malfunctioning system can be found by reading the code displayed on the malfunction indicator lamp.
4. Fail–Safe System
When a malfunction has occurred in any system, there is a possibility of causing engine trouble due to continued control
based on that system. In that case, the fail–safe system either controls the system using the data (Standard values)
recorded in the engine control module memory, or else stops the engine.
95
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control for 1GR–FE
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
J34
See Page
A11
34 (1GR–FE)
I3
35 (1GR–FE)
B
A12
34 (1GR–FE)
I4
35 (1GR–FE)
A13
34 (1GR–FE)
I5
35 (1GR–FE)
J40
A
40
J37
38
38
A16
A
36
I6
35 (1GR–FE)
J41
B
40
A17
B
36
I9
35 (1GR–FE)
J47
A
38
A24
36
I10
35 (1GR–FE)
J48
B
38
A32
36
I11
35 (1GR–FE)
J49
C
38
C2
34 (1GR–FE)
I12
35 (1GR–FE)
J50
D
38
C3
34 (1GR–FE)
I13
35 (1GR–FE)
J51
E
38
J52
F
38
C4
A
34 (1GR–FE)
I14
35 (1GR–FE)
C8
A
37
I18
37
C9
B
37
J2
A
35 (1GR–FE)
C10
C
37
J3
B
35 (1GR–FE)
D1
E2
37
J4
38
K1
K2
35 (1GR–FE)
A
L4
M1
35 (1GR–FE)
40
A
35 (1GR–FE)
34 (1GR–FE)
J5
38
P1
35 (1GR–FE)
E4
A
37
J7
38
P2
35 (1GR–FE)
E5
B
37
J8
A
38
S11
39
E6
C
37
J9
B
38
S12
39
E7
D
37
J16
38
S28
35 (1GR–FE)
E8
E
37
J18
38
T2
35 (1GR–FE)
34 (1GR–FE)
J22
38
T8
39
F8
F9
A
37
J27
38
V1
A
35 (1GR–FE)
F10
B
37
J28
38
V2
A
35 (1GR–FE)
F14
40
J29
A
38
V3
A
35 (1GR–FE)
H6
34 (1GR–FE)
J30
B
38
V4
A
35 (1GR–FE)
H8
34 (1GR–FE)
J31
A
38
I1
35 (1GR–FE)
J32
B
38
I2
35 (1GR–FE)
J33
A
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
1D
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1E
1G
1H
1J
1K
1L
3C
3D
3E
96
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Y1
39
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EC1
45 (1GR–FE)
Engine Wire and Differential Wire (Near the Front Differential)
ED1
45 (1GR–FE)
Engine Wire and Sensor Wire (Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block)
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IK1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Upper Side of the Glove Box)
IL1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Upper Side of the Glove Box)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IB1
IB2
IC2
IC3
IC4
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
45 (1GR–FE)
Front Left Fender
EE
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
EF
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
97
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B B
B–Y
15A
IG1
2
Y–R
D
G–W
2
1
4
B
2 1L
16 1F
5
1
3
2
2
2
E
E
D
E
STPO
24 1E
10 1F
C A
322
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
E
J1
Junction
Connector
2
2
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
B A
R–Y
EB
B–R
(IG)
B–R
B
8 1J
Y–R
Y–R
Y–R
10A
STOP
BATT CHG Relay
A
W–B
A
STOP LP
CTRL Relay
Y–R
G–W
2
LG
F B
G–B
1
S12
Stop Light SW
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
Y–R
Y–R
(BAT)
B B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B
J4
Junction
Connector
G–Y
R–Y
J25
Junction
Connector
2 IM1
G–Y
J4
Junction
Connector
R–Y
R
G–B
R–Y
H A
W–B
R–Y
H A
J33
Junction
Connector
A
G–Y
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
J7
Junction
Connector
A
Y–R(∗2)
Y–R(∗1)
2
Y–R
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
Trailer Towing
(BAT)
30A
BATT
CHG
2
20 1E
2
Y–R
Y–R
C
C
2
3
3
1
3
1 IM1
2
5
B
3
3
E
16
2 IB2
12 1J
G–Y
B–R
R–Y
G–Y
Y–R(∗2)
Y–R(∗1)
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : w/o Daytime Running Light
(BAT)
(BAT)
50A
J/B
(BAT)
30A
TOWING
BRK
10A
TAIL
(BAT)
30A
TOWING
40A
TOWING
2
2
L–Y
2
L–B
L–Y
L–B
A
D
A
L–B
L
D
L–Y
2
2
B
G
L–W
2
GR
5 1L
2
L
4 IB2
25 IC4
3
B
LTOT
STIN
GND
2
4
8
6
3 BG1
4 BG1
C B
C B
3
STTL
W–B
BR
G
5
STTR
GND
4
6
Y
1 BF1
3 BF1
A B
G–Y
A A
W–B
Y
R–Y
G–Y
1 BG1
B–R
2 BG1
A B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
B/UP
2
W
BATT
B
BRK
7
Y
W–B
1
TAIL
T15
Trailer Socket
L
A B
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction Connector
Body ECU
W–B
TRLY
2 BF1
A A
W–B
RTOT
T14
Towing Converter
Relay
GR
TOWING TAIL
Relay
3
3 IB2
18
18 IE1
9
LTIN
W–B
Y
16 1E
3
RTIN
J41(B)
Junction
Connector
1
3
G–Y
3
+B
L–O
4
1
R
BRK
5
L
GND
W–B
STOP
2
L–R
+B
3
G–B
2
1
G–B
5
TAIL
T6
Towing Brake
Controller
2
B
3
G
1
TAIL Relay
5
3
J39
Junction
Connector
B
J16
Junction
Connector
1 1C
B–R
R–Y
G–Y
Y–R(∗1)
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
BO
W–B
Y–R(∗1)
W–B
Y–R(∗2)
W–B
Y–R(∗2)
BL
323
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Trailer Towing
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : w/o Daytime Running Light
(BAT)
15A
TRN–HAZ
L–Y
2
L–B
B–Y
2
9 1F
20 IC4
15 1F
B–Y
(∗2)
2
LR
+B
IG
(∗2)
Y–R
3
TRL
TRR
(∗1)
B–Y
6
B
D2
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
1
(∗2)
IF1
Y–R
1
5
IG
T9
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
1
(∗2)
4
Y–R
LL
B–Y
(∗2)
L–Y
(∗2)
L–B
3
(∗1)
IF1
L–Y
6
(∗1)
IF1
(∗2)
B–Y
(∗2)
L–Y
3
L–B
IF1
(∗1)
5
5 1J
(∗2)
L–B
23 1J
Y–R(∗2)
Y–R(∗1)
324
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
D2
J1
J2
B
See Page
J14
A
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
J15
B
38
35 (1GR–FE)
A
J3
Code
37
J16
Code
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
J20
A
38
35 (1GR–FE)
J21
B
38
P1
S12
S28
See Page
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
39
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
J25
38
T6
39
35 (1GR–FE)
J33
38
T9
39
J4
38
40
T14
41
J5
38
J40
J39
A
40
T15
41
J7
38
J41
B
40
: Relay Blocks
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
2
22
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
3
23
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1C
1E
1F
1J
1L
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IB2
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Relay Wire (Behind the Instrument Panel J/B)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
BF1
48
Frame No.3 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Rear Side of Side Frame LH)
BG1
48
Floor No.2 Wire and Frame No.3 Wire (Rear Side of Side Frame LH)
: Ground Points
Code
EB
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
325
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Tire Pressure Warning System
(IG)
D1
Data Link Connector 3
10A
ECU–IG
SIL
B–R
G
D
P–L
G
H
G
H
J18
Junction
Connector
V–R
P–L
J20
Junction
Connector
R–Y
G
13
R–Y
B–R
28 1J
TC
7
A 3A
C 3C
B 3D
11 1K
A 3A
C 3C
B 3D
1 1G
E A
G A
V–R
V–R
R–Y
B–R
D
P–L
J12
Junction
Connector
A 3D
F A
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
V–R
A B
G B
R–Y
P–L
V–R
A 3D
4
12
3
B–R
H B
2
RF5V
RDA
GND2
IND
8
7
16
6
30 IE1
32 IE1
33 IE1
GR
LG–B
12 BD1
11 BD1
1 BD1
GR
LG–B
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
L
A B
L
W–B
LG–B
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
SPD
GR
GND
11
TC
P–B
SIL
L
IG
A A
1
4
+5V
RDA
GND
W–B
5
T17
Tire Pressure Warning
Antenna and Receiver
A
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
326
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
P–B
(IG)
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
∗ 1 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 2 : 1GR–FE
10A
DOME
2
2
R–L
R
4 1G
R
10 IC4
D
J7
Junction
Connector
R
D
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
V–R
R–L
R
5 B
15 C
16 C
Speedometer
V–R
F B
4 B
7 IC2
13 C
GR–R
7 IM1
12
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
ED
BR
(∗2)
BR
SP1
(∗1)
P–B
BR
GR–R
1 A
P–B
Tire Pressure
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
EE
327
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Tire Pressure Warning System
System Outline
The air pressure sensor installed in the tire wheel detects the tire air pressure and transmits signals to the vehicle side
receiver. When the detected tire air pressure is below a specified level, the warning light in the combination meter comes on
to inform the driver.
Warnings when the tire pressure is low
∗ When the tire air pressure is below a specified level, the warning light in the combination meter comes on.
: Parts Location
Code
C8
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
A
37
J12
38
J35
C9
B
37
J18
38
J36
C10
C
37
J20
38
D1
37
J29
A
38
J7
38
J30
B
38
J37
S28
See Page
A
38
B
38
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
J8
A
38
J33
A
38
T16
39
J9
B
38
J34
B
38
T17
41
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1G
1J
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1K
3A
3C
3D
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IC2
IC4
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
: Ground Points
Code
ED
EE
IK
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
46
Right Kick Panel
328
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
329
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
B 4(A), B 5(B)
Body ECU
(BAT)
(IG)
(ACC)
15A
IG1
140A
ALT
7. 5A
ACC
ACC
22
RDEF
GND2
6
16
GND1
4
2
B–R
1
20 1E
2
2
2
E
2
2
W–B
3
2 1H
Y–G
R
4
3 1B
Y–R
DEFOG Relay
5
J1
Junction
Connector
Y–G
Y–R
R
Y–R
B–R
W–B
E
W–B
1 B
R21(A), R22(B)
Rear Window
Defogger
1 A
W–B
3 BH1
W–B
B
J3
Junction
Connector
W–B
B
A A
W–B
W–B
A B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
A A
W–B
W–B
10 BD1
W–B
EB
BO
330
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BL
B 4(A), B 5(B)
Body ECU
DEFSW
1 B
DIND
5 B
G–R
G
B–R
4
11
2
Y–G
1
1
30A
DEFOG
7 BH1
J6
Junction Connector
10A
MIR
HEATER
DFSW
DIND
B
GND
2
B
7
B
D3
Defogger SW
5
5
W–B
B 3F
B 3F
W–B
W–B
B
J38
Junction
Connector
B
B 3F
W–B
4
W–B
W–B
M4
Mirror Heater RH
B–L
B–L
4
G–B
Y–G
D
18 IP1
W–B
Y–G
D
18 IA1
M3
Mirror Heater LH
B–L
4 IC4
G–B
Y–G
18 IC4
J22
Junction
Connector
Y–G
36 IE1
B–L
2
W–B
2
B
B–L
4 BD1
2
W–B
4 IA2
W–B
J5
Junction
Connector
A
IG
W–B
W–B
A
A
J24
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
J37
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
4 IP2
A
IK
II
331
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
BECU
MPX2
1 A
BECU
5 A
SIG
GND
6 A
3 A
IC+
11 B
IC2
17 B
IC1
16 B
IC–
23 B
L–W
B–O
W–R
9 BD1 7 BD1 5 BD1
Y–G
40 IE1
2
L–R
R
10A ECU–B
4 1B 12 1F
BR–R
(BAT)
10A ECU–IG
(IG)
MPX2
23 A
11
W–B
SIG
10
B
B 4(A), B 5(B)
Body ECU
B–R
W–R
W–R
W–R
8 1F
W–R
2
1
BR–R
2
6
PLS
B–R
SSRB
F
F
E
E
J39
Junction
Connector
W–B
332
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B11
Back Door Power Window Motor
3
PLS2
E
System Outline
∗ Start control
Turning the rear window defogger SW ON, with the ignition SW ON and the back door window fully closed, initiates
operation of the rear window defogger and illuminates the indicator lamp for 15 minutes.
∗ Stop control
When any one of the following conditions exists, rear window defogger operation comes to a stop and the indicator lamp
goes out.
∗ The ignition SW is turned from the ON position to either the ACC or OFF position.
∗ The rear window defogger SW is pressed ON again when rear window defogger operation is already under way.
∗ The back door window is open.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
A
36
B5
B
36
35 (1GR–FE)
J40
A
40
B8
A
40
J5
38
J41
B
40
B9
B
40
J6
38
M3
B11
40
J22
38
M4
D3
37
J24
38
R21
A
41
33 (2UZ–FE)
J37
38
R22
B
41
35 (1GR–FE)
J38
40
J1
J3
33 (2UZ–FE)
See Page
B4
J39
40
41
41
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1E
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
3F
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BH1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Back Door No.2 Wire (Left Side of Back Door)
IA2
IP1
IP2
: Ground Points
Code
EB
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
333
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Navigation, Parking Assist and Audio System
(BAT)
(ACC)
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
7. 5A
ACC
20A
EFI
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
(BAT)
ACC
11 G
2
2
CA+
CGND
24 B
21 B
V+
V–
22 B
23 B
2
8 1K
R
W
B
(∗1)
25 IE1
23 IE1
21 IE1
R
W
B
(∗1)
(∗2)
B 3C
(∗1)
B 3C
L–Y
GR
C
GR
28 IC4
L–Y
P
19 IE1
B 3C
J6
Junction
Connector
C
C
F 3E
(∗1)
L–Y
L–Y
2
B
1 G
3 BD2
2 BD2
1 BD2
4 BD2
F 3E
BR
R
5 BH1
4 BH1
10 BH1
W
B
(∗1)
BR
B
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
GR
(∗2)
GR
9 BH1
1
2
4
2
BR
W–G
(∗1)
2
R
4
R
1
(∗1)
3
ACC CUT Relay
2
2
B 3A
GR
P
2
B
30 IC4
B 3A
W
GR
38 IC4
L
P
B 3A
16 IC3
3
W–G
T11
Television Camera
L–Y
(∗2)
17
ACCR
GR
E8
Engine
Control
Module
(∗2)
GR
334
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
∗ 1 : Shielded
∗ 2 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
R+
29
30
9
R–
L+
L–
SGN2
NTS4
SGN5
25
6
22
20 BJ1
10
(∗1)
(∗2)
(∗2)
P
W
(∗2)
16 ID1
21 BJ1
P
L
(∗2)
L
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
17 ID1
L
VV+
1 C
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗1)
31
(∗2)
19 BJ1
(∗1)
5 BJ1
(∗2)
(∗1)
(∗2)
G
W
18 ID1
(∗2)
8 ID1
G
4 BJ1
R
VV–
4 C
(∗2)
(∗2)
R
W
(∗2)
9 ID1
(∗2)
(∗2)
W
W
(∗2)
3 BJ1
CDL–
5 F
11
SGN1
SG3
NTS1
SG7
AUXR
AUXL
OPEN
8
24
23
7
L–Y
7
5
SLD
NTSC
SGND
2
AUXL
(∗2)
G
LG
(∗2)
9 BJ1
G
4 ID1
(∗2)
(∗2)
LG
W
(∗2)
20 ID1
LG
(∗2)
V
W
(∗2)
1
AUXR
17 BJ1
(∗2)
(∗2)
3
SGND
21 ID1
V
(∗2)
(∗1)
6
(∗1)
19 ID1
16 BJ1
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗1)
(∗2)
R
W
18 BJ1
(∗2)
22 ID1
R
G
23 ID1
15 BJ1
(∗2)
(∗2)
G
GR
(∗2)
14 BJ1
(∗2)
(∗1)
(∗2)
(∗2)
24 ID1
(∗1)
BR
(∗2)
13 ID1
13 BJ1
(∗1)
LG
(∗2)
24 BJ1
(∗2)
BR
(∗2)
R18
Rear Seat Audio
Controller
10 ID1
W
B
2 BJ1
CDL+
4 F
(∗2)
(∗2)
B
W
(∗2)
11 ID1
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗1)
(∗1)
(∗2)
V
GR
(∗2)
7 ID1
(∗2)
(∗1)
(∗2)
LG
V
G
6 BJ1
6 ID1
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗2)
G
W
(∗2)
GND6
12
(∗2)
(∗2)
ACC4
CDR–
3 F
28
SG1
15
L–Y
(∗2)
7 BJ1
27
LMUT
(∗2)
+B2
16
1 BJ1
26
TX–
CDR+
2 F
12 ID1
8 BJ1
13
TX+
CSLD
1 F
5 ID1
10 BJ1
GR
14
3 ID1
LG
L
(∗2)
11 BJ1
L–Y
MUTE
6 F
(∗2)
(∗2)
R
LG
(∗2)
2 ID1
LG
TXM–
10 F
(∗2)
TXM+
9 F
(∗2)
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
8
CE
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
V14
Video Terminal
GR
GR
IJ
335
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Navigation, Parking Assist and Audio System
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
SW1
SGND
4 IV1
1
IT1
2
IT1
3
IT1
4
1
IT1
BR
(∗3)
(∗1)
ARO
(∗3)
ALO
P
W
5
(∗3)
L
4
L
B
3
(∗3)
G
2
(∗3)
R
12
1
8 E
10
AU1
ASGN
AUXO
MACC
1
MIC+
MIC–
II1
11
EAU
SEEK+
3
2
II1
Y–B
3 IV1
II1
V–W
2 IV1
SW2
6 E
(∗3)
(∗1)
(∗1)
(∗3)
P
(∗3)
L
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
3
1 IV1
SWG
7 E
18 B
Y–B
TSW–
12 B
W–R
MIC–
20 B
W–R
19 B
V–W
MIC+
MACC
17 B
B
L
ADPG
6 C
(∗1)
VA–
5 C
G
VAR+
2 C
R
VAL+
3 C
AU2
MODE
SEEK–
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
T18
Telephone Microphone
VOL+
VOL–
C13
Combination SW
∗ 1 : Shielded
∗ 3 : w/ Telephone Microphone
GR
GR
BR
(∗3)
336
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
IVO+
IVO–
SLD1
12 E
ANT
13 G
13 E
L+
L–
R+
R–
9 G
19 G
8 G
18 G
SLD
10 G
ATX+
5 G
ATX–
MUTE
15 G
7 G
W–R
18 IO2
W–R
W
27 IO2
W
B
26 IO2
B
(∗1)
34 IO2
(∗1)
W
35 IO2
W
B
32 IO2
B
G
31 IO2
G
R
22 A
INT+
29 IO2
R
23 A
A37
Antenna
Amplifier
(∗1)
37 IO2
(∗1)
(∗1)
P
39 IO2
(∗1)
+B
P
40 IO2
1
L
L
B
11 E
3 A
2 A
5 A
4 A
6 A
8 A
7 A
1 A
L+
L–
R+
R–
INT–
SLD
TX+
TX–
MUTE
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
ACC
FL+
FL–
6 B
FR–
RL+
RL–
RR+
RR–
W
1
2
1
3 BB1
B
1 BB1
L
P
2
3 BA1
1
2
1
2
1
2
GR
1
W
3
1 BA1
W
W
4
R
R
2
3
S21
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 2
4
LG
8 IP2
L
3 IP2
V
1 IA2
R–L
3 IA2
R
22 IO2
Y
24 IO2
Y
16 IO2
B
14 IO2
L
10 IO2
LG
12 IO2
V
20 IO2
P
R
14 B
Y
5 B
B
13 B
L
4 B
LG
18 B
V
7 B
21 IO2
S20
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 2
38 IO2
FR+
17 B
P
GR
12 A
D22
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 1
D23
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 1
R16
Rear Door
Speaker LH
GR
R17
Rear Door
Speaker RH
BR
(∗3)
BR
(∗3)
337
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Navigation, Parking Assist and Audio System
∗ 3 : w/ Telephone Microphone
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
(BAT)
(IG)
20A
RADIO
NO. 2
PKB
1 D
GND
20 G
SPD
15A
IG1
REV
3 D
5 D
2
8 1J
Y–R
W–L
R–Y
V–R
BR
LG
2
A
27 IC4
W–L
20 1J
J7
Junction
Connector
Y–R
H
W4
Woofer
36 IO2
4
1
3
L–B
L–R
19 B
9 B
20 B
WFR+
1 B
10 B
WFR–
+B
A 3B
B 3D
A
J33
Junction
Connector
B
+B2
A
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
23 IO2
B 3D
B 3D
Y–R
A 3B
V–R
A 3B
V–R
SPD
11 A
25 IO2
BR
(∗3)
V–R
16 B
BR
GND
15 B
BR
GND2
2 IM1
BR
G–B
CTR–
12 B
G
CTR+
3 B
J25
Junction
Connector
41 IO2
2
R
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
WFL–
W–L
G–W
8 B
B
W–L
BR
B
B
Y–R
2
J42
Junction
Connector
R–Y
WF–
V–R
WF+
BR
WF–
Y–R
R–Y
B
WF+
WFL+
J20
Junction
Connector
H
1
W–L
P4
Parking Brake SW
1 1E
LG
A
R–Y
V–R
1
G
C5
Center Speaker
1 IM1
V–R
R–Y
3
G
BR
G–B
4
BR
G
J29
Junction
Connector
BR
V–R
(∗3)
BR
W–B
(w/ Side Airbag)
BM
BP
IJ
338
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
(BAT)
(IG)
10A
DOME
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
2
R
4 1G
J7
Junction
Connector
D
10 IC4
R
R–L
R
D
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
F B
16 C
13 C
4 B
BR
GR–R
5 B
V–R
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
Speedometer
15 C
7 IC2
7 IM1
GR–R
1 1G
11 1K
12
EE
BR
BR
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
(2UZ–FE)
V–R
(1GR–FE)
SP1
ED
339
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Navigation, Parking Assist and Audio System
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A37
Code
36
C5
See Page
J29
Code
R26
B
39
R27
C
39
37
J33
A
38
C9
B
37
J34
B
38
S20
C10
C
37
40
S21
J42
See Page
38
41
41
C13
37
D22
40
D23
40
E8
37
R9
D
39
J6
38
R10
E
39
S31
39
J7
38
R11
F
39
T11
41
R12
G
39
T18
41
P1
P4
33 (2UZ–FE)
S22
A
41
35 (1GR–FE)
S23
B
41
39
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
J8
A
38
J9
B
38
R16
41
V14
39
J20
38
R17
41
W4
41
J25
38
R18
41
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1E
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1K
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
ID1
46
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
II1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IO2
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IP2
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IC2
IC3
IC4
IT1
47
Roof Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IV1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Console Box No.2 Wire (Rear Console)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD2
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BH1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Back Door No.2 Wire (Left Side of Back Door)
BJ1
48
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly (Center of Roof)
340
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Ground Points
Code
ED
EE
See Page
Ground Points Location
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IJ
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BM
48
Floor Seat Crossmember RH
BP
48
Rear Pillar RH
341
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Audio System with 10 Speaker
GR
(ACC)
(BAT)
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
7. 5A
ACC
20A
EFI
2
2
GND6
12
+B2
TX+
16
TX–
14
LMUT
26
13
V
LG
G
(∗1)
(∗1)
8 BJ1
(∗1)
LG
W
10 BJ1
(∗1)
11 BJ1
(∗1)
L
(∗1)
(∗1)
BR
(∗1)
L–Y
LG
7 BJ1
(∗1)
F 3E
24 BJ1
LG
LG
P
6 BJ1
(∗1)
L–Y
GR
2
(∗1)
8 1K
2
ACC4
15
(∗1)
(BAT)
28 IC4
2 ID1
3 ID1
5 ID1
V
(∗1)
G
R
(∗1)
(∗1)
6 ID1
L–Y
BR
(∗1)
13 ID1
(∗1)
GR
GR
L
P
J6
Junction
Connector
C
C
(∗1)
7 ID1
L–Y
F 3E
4
MUTE
R 1(A), R 4(B), R 5(C)
Radio and Player
B 3A
B 3A
B
B 3A
2
6 B
ACC
1 A
11 A
GND
20 A
2
B 3C
B 3C
W–G
GR
BR
1
TXM–
GR
3
ACC CUT Relay
2
2
10 B
TXM+
L–Y
GR
2
9 B
GR
30 IC4
GR
38 IC4
P
C
B 3C
16 IC3
W–G
L–Y
A 3B
A 3B
ACCR
BR
17
E8
Engine
Control
Module
BR
(∗1)
IJ
342
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
GR
GR
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
LG
W
9 BJ1
(∗1)
LG
17 BJ1
G
24
(∗1)
OPEN
8
(∗1)
AUXL
(∗1)
(∗1)
V
W
16 BJ1
(∗1)
(∗1)
18 BJ1
(Shielded)
W
15 BJ1
AUXR
7
(∗1)
(Shielded)
(∗1)
R
SG7
23
(∗1)
(∗1)
G
GR
(∗1)
(Shielded)
(∗1)
14 BJ1
(∗1)
13 BJ1
(Shielded)
(∗1)
G
W
(∗1)
22
7
5
SLD
NTSC
3
SGND
1
AUXR
G
LG
2
4 ID1
(∗1)
20 ID1
(∗1)
V
6
SGND
(∗1)
21 ID1
(∗1)
19 ID1
(Shielded)
R
22 ID1
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
(Shielded)
(∗1)
23 ID1
8
AUXL
CE
V14
Video Terminal
G
24 ID1
5 B
CDL–
R 1(A), R 4(B), R 5(C)
Radio and Player
ALI
ARI
ASGN
AUXI
16 C
19 C
2 IV1
3 IV1
4 IV1
1
2
ALO
ARO
L
1 IV1
L
15 C
B
17 C
G
CDL+
SGN5
6
8 ID1
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
(∗1)
W
R
4 B
5 BJ1
NTS4
G
CDR–
9 ID1
(∗1)
(∗1)
W
W
(∗1)
3 B
4 BJ1
SGN2
25
R
CDR+
10 ID1
W
(∗1)
B
W
(∗1)
2 B
3 BJ1
L–
31
R
CSLD
11 ID1
L+
30
(Shielded)
1 B
2 BJ1
B
(∗1)
12 ID1
R–
29
(∗1)
(Shielded)
(∗1)
(∗1)
(Shielded)
1 BJ1
(Shielded)
R+
28
(∗1)
SG1
27
3
ASGN
4
AUXO
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
343
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Audio System with 10 Speaker
GR
GR
R
G
B
W
(Shielded)
W
35 IO2
B
32 IO2
G
31 IO2
R
(Shielded)
29 IO2
9 A
19 A
8 A
18 A
L+
L–
R+
R–
34 IO2
10 A
SLD
R 1(A), R 4(B), R 5(C)
Radio and Player
SWG
ATX–
B
Y–B
15 A
II1
2
MUTE
7 A
W–R
1
ATX+
5 A
W
II1
ANT
13 A
8 C
W–R
V–W
3
SW2
6 C
B
SW1
7 C
26 IO2
27 IO2
18 IO2
II1
12
10
AU1
SEEK+
+B
Y–B
V–W
W–R
1
11
EAU
AU2
A37
Antenna
Amplifier
MODE
SEEK–
VOL+
VOL–
C13
Combination SW
344
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–R
W
B
GR
(BAT)
20A
RADIO NO. 2
2
W–L
2
R16
Rear Door
Speaker LH
R
G
27 IC4
W
1 BA1
3 BA1
1 BB1
3 BB1
Y
R
W
14 IO2
16 IO2
24 IO2
22 IO2
W
B
G
R
GR
W–L
W–L
B
Y
R
W
B
(Shielded)
B
B
W–L
GR
J42
Junction
Connector
B
2
R
36 IO2
1
Y
W–L
38 IO2
W
(Shielded)
2
B
GR
1
B
R17
Rear Door
Speaker RH
6 A
4 A
5 A
2 A
3 A
12 A
1 B
10 B
4 B
13 B
5 B
14 B
R–
R+
L–
L+
SLD
ACC
+B
+B2
RL+
RL–
RR+
RR–
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
FL+
FL–
FR+
CTR+
FR–
7 B
CTR–
20 IO2
12 IO2
10 IO2
23 IO2
25 IO2
L
21 IO2
LG
G–B
12 B
G
3 B
L
18 B
LG
17 B
V
6 B
V
TX+
8 A
P
TX–
7 A
P
MUTE
1 A
3 IA2
1 IA2
3 IP2
8 IP2
G
G–B
W–R
4
3
R
W
4
3
1
2
1
LG
1
2
D22
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 1
C5
Center Speaker
L
S20
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 2
S21
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 2
L
2
3
V
4
P
B
R–L
W
1
2
D23
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 1
345
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Audio System with 10 Speaker
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
2
4 1G
R
W4
Woofer
J7
Junction
Connector
D
WF–
WF+
WF–
2
4
1
3
R
D
R–L
R
WF+
10 IC4
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
L–R
R
19 B
WFL+
9 B
WFL–
15 C
16 C
5 B
4 B
Speedometer
8 B
L–B
BR
G–W
F B
20 B
WFR+
WFR–
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
7 IM1
V–R
12
SP1
B 3D
G–W
4
3
BR
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
BR
BR
22 IE1
R20
Rear Speaker RH
(2UZ–FE)
V–R
11 1K
B 3D
20 IE1
7 IC2
G
BR
G–W
10 IO3
BR
BR
J29
Junction
Connector
3
1 1G
G
BR
G–W
4
11 IO3
13 C
GR–R
D
V–R
D
BR
C
BR
C
G–W
41 IO2
(1GR–FE)
J42
Junction
Connector
GR–R
SPD
11 A
V–R
D
GND
16 B
V–R
BR
C
15 B
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
GND2
DRS–
11 B
G–W
DRS+
2 B
R19
Rear Speaker LH
W–B
(w/ Side Airbag)
BP
BM
346
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
ED
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A37
36
C5
Code
J9
See Page
B
Code
38
See Page
S20
41
37
J29
38
C9
B
37
J42
40
S22
A
41
C10
C
37
R1
A
39
S23
B
41
C13
37
R4
B
39
D22
40
R5
C
39
D23
40
R16
41
S31
39
E8
37
R17
41
V14
39
J6
38
R18
41
W4
41
J7
38
R19
41
38
R20
41
J8
A
S21
41
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1G
1K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
ID1
46
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
II1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IP2
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IV1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Console Box No.2 Wire (Rear Console)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BJ1
48
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly (Center of Roof)
IC2
IC3
IC4
IO2
IO3
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
EE
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IJ
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BM
48
Floor Seat Crossmember
BP
48
Rear Pillar RH
347
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Audio System with 6 Speaker
(BAT)
(BAT)
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
(ACC)
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
7. 5A
ACC
20A
EFI
+B2
16
2
ACC4
GND6
15
12
TX+
14
TX–
LMUT
26
13
11 BJ1
10 BJ1
V
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
L
24 BJ1
(∗1)
BR
(∗1)
GR
6 BJ1
8 BJ1
28 IC4
F 3E
6 ID1
7 ID1
2 ID1
3 ID1
LG
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
LG
A37
Antenna
Amplifier
13 ID1
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
LG
J6
Junction
Connector
C
C
(∗1)
P
L–Y
7 BJ1
(∗1)
8 1K
2
(∗1)
2
L–Y
2
5 ID1
BR
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
(∗1)
9 C
TXM–
SWG
1
II1
2
12
10
II1
11
EAU
AU2
A 3B
W–G
AU1
GND
7 A
8 D
Y–B
V–W
L–Y
II1
V–W
3
SW2
6 D
BR
SW1
7 D
2
16 IC3
10 C
Y–B
+B
4 A
W–G
2
ACC
3 A
W–R
4
TXM+
R 2(A), R 3(B), R 4(C), R 5(D)
Radio and Player
W–R
1
B 3A
GR
3
ANT
ACC CUT Relay
L–Y
2
2
SEEK+
MODE
A 3B
17
ACCR
E8
Engine
Control
Module
V
(∗1)
G
B 3A
8 A
2
(∗1)
B
R
P
B 3C
(∗1)
L–Y
GR
(∗1)
30 IC4
+B
1
B 3C
GR
B 3C
GR
GR
38 IC4
L
P
(∗1)
L–Y
L–Y
C
F 3E
SEEK–
BR
VOL+
VOL–
C13
Combination SW
BR
(∗1)
IJ
348
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
6 C
MUTE
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
3 C
CDR+
CDR–
G
(∗1)
9 BJ1
LG
17 BJ1
(∗1)
LG
24
(∗1)
OPEN
8
W
V
(∗1)
AUXL
(∗1)
(∗1)
(Shielded)
16 BJ1
W
(∗1)
(Shielded)
(∗1)
R
W
AUXR
7
18 BJ1
(∗1)
G
GR
15 BJ1
(∗1)
(∗1)
(Shielded)
14 BJ1
SG7
23
(∗1)
22
(∗1)
SGN5
6
(Shielded)
(∗1)
G
W
(∗1)
7
5
SLD
NTSC
3
SGND
1
SGND
2
AUXR
AUXL
G
4 ID1
(∗1)
LG
20 ID1
(∗1)
(∗1)
V
6
(∗1)
21 ID1
(Shielded)
R
19 ID1
(∗1)
22 ID1
(∗1)
(∗1)
23 ID1
8
CE
V14
Video Terminal
G
4 C
24 ID1
G
8 ID1
(Shielded)
W
9 ID1
NTS4
13 BJ1
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
5 BJ1
(∗1)
4 BJ1
SGN2
25
(∗1)
L–
31
R
W
W
2 C
CSLD
(∗1)
10 ID1
W
B
1 C
(∗1)
(∗1)
B
W
(∗1)
11 ID1
(∗1)
12 ID1
L+
30
3 BJ1
(∗1)
(Shielded)
(∗1)
2 BJ1
(∗1)
(Shielded)
1 BJ1
(Shielded)
R–
29
(∗1)
R+
28
(∗1)
SG1
27
5 C
CDL+
CDL–
R 2(A), R 3(B), R 4(C), R 5(D)
Radio and Player
2
D22
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 1
1 BA1
3 BA1
1 BB1
3 BB1
L
P
1
W
1
R
2
RR–
3 B
R
1
RR+
1 B
S21
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 2
3
RL–
6 B
Y
L
W
LG
R
4
S20
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 2
2
3
LG
V
8 IP2
L
3 IP2
V
P
1 IA2
R–L
3 IA2
4
RL+
2 B
W
FR–
5 A
Y
FR+
1 A
B
FL–
6 A
B
FL+
2 A
1
2
D23
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 1
1
2
R16
Rear Door
Speaker LH
1
2
R17
Rear Door
Speaker RH
349
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Audio System with 6 Speaker
(IG)
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
10A
DOME
2
4 1G
R
2
J7
Junction
Connector
D
10 IC4
R
R–L
R
D
H A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
F B
16 C
5 B
4 B
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
Speedometer
15 C
R 2(A), R 3(B), R 4(C), R 5(D)
Radio and Player
4 IV1
B 3D
1 1G
7 IC2
13 C
BR
3 IV1
GR–R
2 IV1
V–R
1 IV1
L
V–R
SPD
3 D
L
AUXI
19 D
B
G
ASGN
16 D
G
R
ARI
15 D
R
(Shielded)
ALI
17 D
1
2
ALO
ARO
3
ASGN
4
AUXO
B 3D
11 1K
GR–R
7 IM1
EE
350
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
BR
(2UZ–FE)
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
BR
SP1
(1GR–FE)
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
V–R
12
ED
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A37
Code
36
See Page
J7
Code
See Page
38
R17
41
C9
B
37
J8
A
38
R18
41
C10
C
37
J9
B
38
S20
41
C13
37
R2
A
39
S21
41
D22
40
R3
B
39
D23
40
R4
C
39
E8
37
R5
D
39
S31
39
J6
38
41
V14
39
R16
S28
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1G
1K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IA2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
ID1
46
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
II1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Instrument Panel Brace LH)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IP2
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IV1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Console Box No.2 Wire (Rear Console)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BJ1
48
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly (Center of Roof)
IC2
IC3
IC4
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
EE
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IJ
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
351
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
3 A
4 A
5 A
BR–B
Y–G
2 A
Y–B
Y
Illumination
N
D
4
3
2
L
R
P
OFF
LO
N
HI
Illumination
Height Control
G–B
R–Y
G–W
W
G
L
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
Suspension Control ECU
352
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
P–L
B–L
Transmission Control SW
Transmission Control SW
Park/Neutral Position SW
Transmission Control SW
Park/Neutral Position SW
Combination Meter
20 D
1 C
19 D
18 D
17 D
16 D
15 D
14 D
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
H A
D
3 C
1 IE1
2 IE1
2
MAINT
16 C
11 C
18 B
12 B
13 B
L–R
R
11 1J
Airbag Sensor Assembly
5 C
G–Y
R
(IG)
Buckle SW LH
3
Fuel
B
LG
B–O
10A
IGN
Passenger Seat Belt
Warning Light
Driver' s
Seat Belt
15 C
Y–B
D B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
Y–B
9 C
R
A B
B–O
C A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R–L
1 1C
J16
Junction
Connector
G
L–W
4 1G
BR–R
8 C
W–L
5
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
G
FR FOG Relay
HEAD (HI RH) Fuse
B
7. 5A
GAUGE
BR–R
19 B
V–G
10 D
(IG)
F14
Fuel Sender
7 B
L–B
2
10A
TAIL
Body ECU
16 B
B–Y
G
23 IC4
TAIL Relay
G
R–W
1
5 1L
A/C Control Assembly
7 C
W–G
Tail (Except USA)
Door
R–W
50A
J/B
Park/Neutral Position SW
17 A
V–Y
Front Fog
Beam
2
Rheostat
13 D
R–G
12 D
Body ECU
Combination SW
Head (USA)
(BAT)
(BAT)
10A
DOME
2
2
10 IC4
R
J7
Junction
Connector
D
F B
R
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
3
353
Combination Meter
TAC
TACH
9
13
F B
B–W
G A
13 IC5
B–W
B–W
(∗6)
(1GR–FE)
SPD
3
V–R
V–R
5
SPD
3
(∗5)
20 B
SPD
V
19 B
DMIN
(∗1)
DMOT
V–R
SPD
M5
Moon Roof
Control ECU
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control
Assembly
8 A
R5
Radio and
Player
B–W
(2UZ–FE)
R9
Radio and
Player with
Display
V–R
S14
Suspension
Control ECU
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
B–W
(2UZ–FE)
5 1A
F A
W–L
BR–B
SPD
B 3D
B 3D
B 3D
B 3D
F A
14
H B
Body ECU
1 1G
11 1K
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
V–R
Temp.
Fuel
6 B
R–L
8 IM2
13 C
2 C
B–Y
4 B
GR–R
8 B
BR
SRS
Buzzer
Tachometer
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
5 B
3 B
Speedometer
2 B
B–W
V–R
V–R
7 IM1
7 IC2
2
I9
Injector No. 1
GR–R
1
SP1
I9
Injector No. 1
ED
354
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
A32
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
12
BR(1GR–FE)
R–L
D
3
BR(2UZ–FE)
J27
Junction
Connector
(1GR–FE)
R–L
A
(2UZ–FE)
J26
Junction
Connector
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
R–L
D
A
(1GR–FE)
R–L
(2UZ–FE)
LA
(∗2)
A
J2
Junction
Connector
(∗2)
1
1
2
W1
Washer Level Sensor
6 IM1
5 D
4WD Control ECU
15 A
11 A
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L–Y
41 IO2
Daytime Running
Light Relay (∗4)
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
(∗3)
V–R
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
1
2
3
4
5
6
Turn RH
L–R
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
Turn LH
CRUISE
7 A
LG
7 D
A/T OIL TEMP
G A
(∗3)
G B
V–R
G B
S22
Stereo Component Amplifier
SPD
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
9
P
6 D
R–B
G B
4LO
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
BR–W
V–R
3
(4WD)
F9
4WD Control ECU
SPD
Center Diff. Lock
4WD
V–R
T16
Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
1
G–R
(∗2)
Washer
V–R
E7
Engine Control
Module
8
W–G
7 IN1
(∗2)
6 A
V–W
Oil Pressure
G A
V–W
8 A
LG–B
Charge
SPD
W–B
LG–B
16 A
GR
TACH
W–B
O1
Oil Pressure SW
Generator
B–W
: w/ Moon Roof
: Canada
: Except 6 Speaker
: w/ Daytime Running Light
: w/ Navigation System
: 6 Speaker
11
SPD
V–R
10 C
6 C
Engine Control Module
A
EB
355
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
Airbag Sensor Assembly
18 C
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
VSC TRAC
20 C
R
Y–R
17 C
1 A
10 A
L–W
P–B
L–Y
RSCA OFF
Tire Pressure
VSC OFF (4WD)
AUTO LSD (2WD)
Slip
12 A
(4WD)
DAC
BR–Y
BRAKE
19 A
B–L
ABS
4 D
LG–R
Combination Meter
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
356
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A16
A
36
A17
B
36
A32
Code
See Page
33 (2UZ–FE)
J2
36
Code
J32
35 (1GR–FE)
J7
38
See Page
B
M5
O1
38
41
33 (2UZ–FE)
C8
A
37
J8
A
38
C9
B
37
J9
B
38
R5
39
C10
C
37
J10
A
38
R9
39
C11
D
37
J11
B
38
S14
39
S22
41
D1
37
J16
38
E7
37
J26
38
F9
37
J27
38
F14
40
J29
A
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
J30
B
38
35 (1GR–FE)
J31
A
38
I9
S28
T16
W1
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
39
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1C
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1K
1L
3D
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC4
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IO2
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IC5
IE1
IM1
IM2
: Ground Points
Code
EB
ED
EE
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
357
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Air Conditioning
Y–R
(BAT)
(IG)
8 1J
15A
IG1
60A
HEATER
2
2
Y–R
Y–R
E
C
E
4
HEATER
Relay
2
J1
Junction
Connector
2
5
1
2
MG CLT
Relay
J3
Junction
Connector
B–Y
3
2
2
2
B
2
1
2
L–B
1 IC4
2
LG–R
L–B
2
L
B–Y
7. 5A
HEATER
NO. 2
BR–Y
B
G–Y
3 IM1
L–B
5 IN1
36 IC4
43 IC4
37 IC4
B–Y
40 IC4
BR–Y
2
W–G
3
B3
Blower Motor
Controller
3
4
+B
VM
GND
SI
L
W–L
1
1
A2
A/C Lock Sensor
A/C Magnetic Clutch
M
B2
Blower
Motor
G–Y
W–B
D
1
2
2
D
2
1
3
E
Y–R
2
E
P3
Pressure SW
W–B
C
Y–R
5
E
Y–R
Y–R
2
Y–R
R
20 1E
2
1
2
Y–G
LG–R
EB
LG–B
J24
Junction
Connector
W–B
L
LG–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
II
358
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Y–R
(ACC)
A
(BAT)
P
(BAT)
J7
Junction
Connector
7. 5A
ACC
10A
DOME
F 3E
H
2
P
2
F 3E
2
J20
Junction
Connector
Y–R
P
10 IC4
2
GR
3
ACC CUT
Relay
4
C
A
A
A
GR
A 3C
B 3A
A 3C
F
B
R
Y–R
B 3A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
H
A
H
A
R
16 IC3
Y–R
J7
Junction
Connector
D
C
2
GR
W–G
2
D
J6
Junction
Connector
R
1
30 IC4
J25
Junction
Connector
R
2
2
H
L
2
8 1K
R
38 IC4
Y–R
A
20A
EFI
L–B
W–B
IG+
ACC
L–B
8
R
2
W–G
GR
W–B
1
14
7
LIN–B
GND
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
W–B
D3
Heater Control Panel
B
3F
W–B
B
B 3F
BR–Y
W–B
(2UZ–FE)
Y–R
W–G
W–G
W–G
BR–Y
Y–G
LG–R
LG–R
L
L
LG–B
LG–B
J37
Junction
Connector
Y–G
W–B
A
IK
359
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Air Conditioning
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
(BAT)
10A
ECU–B
F B
GR–G
BR–W
24 D
25 D
1 D
L–B
TACH
AC1
ACT
W–B
THW
L–B
THWO
14 D
W–G
ACCR
17 E
E2
21 A
28 A
E 4(A), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
B–W
R
2 IK1
BR–W
G A
1 IK1
GR–G
W–G
B–W
F A
2 IM2
ACT
18 A
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
F A
W–R
AC1
7 B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B 3E
TABC
20 A
B–W
4 1L
MGC
10 B
BR–Y
B 3E
LOCK
19 A
W–G
W–R
4 1B
W–B
W–R
2
IG
1 A
Y–R
VER1
8 B
(2UZ–FE)
GND
5 A
W–B
LIN1
4 A
L–B
+B
2 A
2
W–B
W–G
W–G
BR
(1GR–FE)
B–L
R–L
E2
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Y–R
(2UZ–FE)
(2UZ–FE)
2
1
BR–Y
L–B
Y–G
Y–G
LG–R
LG–R
L
L
LG–B
LG–B
R
360
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
1 B
15 A
6 A
TAM
22 A
GR
7 A
AMHDR(∗1)
AMH(∗2)
14 B
V–W
3 A
AMCDR(∗1)
AMC(∗2)
23 B
V–R
21 A
TPDR(∗1)
TP(∗2)
25 A
L–O
9 B
Y–G
SG
V–Y
TR
P
S5
L–B
TWI
LG–B
BLW
L
HR
LG–R
PSW
39 IC4
GR
2
Y–G
A27(A)
Air Mix Control Servo Motor LH
A26(B)
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
A19
A/C Room Temp. Sensor
Y–G
P
Y–G
Y–G
Y–G
Y–G
L–B
L–B
1 A (∗1)
2 B (∗2)
1
5 IC3
Y–G
I B
M
2 A
1 B
P
H B
D A
5 A (∗1)
4 B (∗2)
4 A
5 B
2
Y–G
L–B
E A
1
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
C 3D
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
C 3D
L–B
3 A
3 B
A1
A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
C 3D
B 3B
P
B
3B
3 IM2
L–B
Y–G
LG–R
L–B
L
LG–B
∗ 1 : Limited
∗ 2 : Except Limited
R
R
361
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Air Conditioning
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
4
5
3
Y–G
A28
Air Mix Control
Servo Motor RH
2
P
1
(∗1)
2
(∗1)
A29
Air Vent Mode
Control Servo
Motor
Y–G
1
5
M
P
1
Y–G
M
P
A25
Air Inlet Control
Servo Motor
Y–G
2
4
Y–G
B 3B
(∗1)
3
L–Y
5
AMCPA
24 B
(∗1)
4
L–R
L–W
3
AMHPA
16 B
(∗1)
LG–R
TPPA
23 A
M
Y–G
AOF
3 B
LG
AOD
4 B
LG–R
TPO
17 A
P–G
AIF
6 B
P–L
AIR
5 B
P–B
TPI
16 A
Y–G
B 3B
B 3B
L–B
L–B
R
R
362
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
24 A
26 A
TSDR(∗1)
TS(∗2)
12 A
DMOT
DMIN
19 B
20 B
W–L
TSPA
BR–B
TE
SPD
8 A
V–G
A21
A/C Solar Sensor
1 1G
P
5 IG1
(∗2)
P
(∗1)
1
Y–G
11 1K
1
V–R
A18
A/C Evaporator
Temp. Sensor
2
2
V–R
B 3D
(∗2)
B 3D
V–R
3
5 IG1
V–G
(∗1)
R
R
6 IG1
A20
A/C Solar
Sensor
2
1
(∗1)
B–O
4 IG1
(∗1)
(∗1)
G
B–O
(∗2)
6 IG1
V–R
(∗1)
P
Y–G
P
W–L
(∗2)
BR–B
B 3B
L–B
L–B
∗ 1 : Limited
∗ 2 : Except Limited
R
R
363
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Air Conditioning
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
(IG)
(IG)
7. 5A
GAUGE
SP1
10A
IGN
4 1G
11 1J
B–O
GR–R
12
R–L
B A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
7 IC2
3 B
2 B
7 B
16 C
BR–B
L–B
R
V–R
Temp.
5 B
C 9(B), C10(C)
Combination Meter
5 C
13 C
BR
15 C
Speedometer
4 B
W–L
B–O
GR–R
D B
W–L
BR–B
7 IM1
BR
(1GR–FE)
(2UZ–FE)
BR
L–B
R
ED
364
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
EE
System Outline
1. Heater Blower Operation
Manual operation
When the blower speed is set to a certain level using the blower control SW, the A/C control assembly sends the signals to
the blower control to control the blower motor speed.
Auto operation
When the auto SW is pushed, the A/C control assembly sends the signals from various sensors and temperature SW to the
blower control to automatically control the blower motor speed.
2. Air Inlet Control Servo Motor Control
When the FRESH/RECIRC select SW is set to RECIRC, the motor in the air inlet control servo motor starts rotating to move
the damper toward the RECIRC side. Since the damper position is detected by the TERMINAL TPI of the A/C control
assembly, the motor is continuously rotated until the damper reaches its stop position. When the FRESH/RECIRC select SW
is set to FRESH, the motor in the air inlet control servo motor starts rotating to move the damper toward the FRESH side.
Since the damper position is detected by the TERMINAL TPI of the A/C control assembly, the motor is continuously rotated
until the damper reaches its stop position.
3. Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor Control
When the mode select SW is pushed, the ECU in the A/C control assembly activates the air vent mode control servo motor.
This causes the servo motor to rotate to the position (FACE, BI–LEVEL, FOOT, FOOT/DEF, DEF) selected using the mode
select SW, and moves the damper.
4. Air Mix Control Servo Motor Control (Limited)
When the temperature control SW on the driver’s side is pressed, the ECU in the A/C control assembly sends a signal to the
air mix control servo motor on the driver’s side. This signal drives the motor to reach the temperature set by the temperature
control SW on the driver’s side, and moves the damper. Passenger’s side is operated as same as the driver’s side.
5. Air Mix Control Servo Motor Control (Except Limited)
When the temperature control SW is pressed, the ECU in the A/C control assembly sends a signal to the air mix control
servo motor. This signal drives the motor to reach the temperature set by the temperature control SW, and moves the film
damper.
6. Air Conditioning Operation
The A/C control assembly receives various signals, I.E., the engine RPM from the engine control module, out side air
temperature signal from the A/C ambient temp. sensor and coolant temperature from the engine control module, etc.
When the engine is started and the A/C SW (A/C control assembly) is on, a signal is input to the A/C control assembly.
As a result, turning the MG CLT relay on, so that the magnetic clutch is on and the A/C compressor operates.
If the A/C control assembly detects the following conditions, it stops the air conditioning:
∗ Evaporator outlet air is too low.
∗ There is a marked difference between the compressor speed and the engine speed.
∗ The refrigerant pressure is abnormally high or abnormally low.
∗ The engine speed is too low.
∗ Rapid acceleration occurs.
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A1
A2
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
32 (2UZ–FE)
B2
36
34 (1GR–FE)
B3
36
J8
J7
A
38
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
C9
B
37
J9
B
38
34 (1GR–FE)
C10
C
37
J10
A
38
37
J11
B
38
A16
A
36
A17
B
36
D3
E2
32 (2UZ–FE)
J20
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J24
38
J25
38
A18
36
A19
36
E4
A
37
A20
36
E7
D
37
J31
A
38
A21
36
E8
E
37
J32
B
38
A25
36
A26
B
36
A27
A
36
A28
36
A29
36
J1
J3
J6
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
38
J37
P3
S28
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
365
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Air Conditioning
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1E
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1G
1J
1K
1L
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC2
IC3
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG1
46
Instrument Panel No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IK1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Upper Side of the Glove Box)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IC4
IM1
IM2
IN1
: Ground Points
Code
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
EE
366
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
367
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Immobiliser System
(IG)
(BAT)
10A
IGN
10A
ECU–B
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
SIL
7
11 1J
G
4 1B
G
J18
Junction
Connector
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
R–Y
W–R
2
B–O
B
R–Y
2
J8
Junction
Connector
Transponder Key Coil
A 3A
4 1L
B–O
W–R
B
A 3A
ANT1
B 3E
R–Y
VC5
9
8
11
12
13
VC5
CODE
TXCT
AGND
EFIO
EFII
6
7
14
3
L–R
W–B
V–W
G–Y
D
W–R
+B
5
B A
IND
LP
GND
15
A
J33
Junction
Connector
IMO
A
CTY
C B
4
A B
J37
Junction
Connector
W–B
A B
J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
W–B
B 3F
W–B
1
B 3F
A
J24
Junction
Connector
A
IK
F
1
K3
Unlock
Warning SW
B 3F
A
J18
Junction
Connector
7
2
E7
Engine Control
Module
F
R–B
IMI
D3
Security
Indicator
Light
W–B
16
KSW
10
G–Y
GND
T8
Transponder Key
Computer
R–B
1
IG
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
B–O
2
7
L
F
W–R
B
GND
5
LG–R
J35
Junction
Connector
TXCT
P–G
F
B 3E
4
GR–B
J31
Junction
Connector
CODE
1
R–Y
B
ANT2
II
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
98
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
D12
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
D1
37
Code
See Page
J8
Code
See Page
38
J33
38
D3
37
J14
A
38
J35
38
D12
40
J15
B
38
J37
38
E7
37
J18
38
K3
39
I17
37
J24
38
T8
39
J5
38
J31
38
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1B
1J
1L
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
3A
3E
3F
: Ground Points
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
99
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN Bus
B 4(A), B 6(C)
Body ECU
MPX3
MPX2
23 A
BR–Y
BR–R
26 C
B
J19
Junction
Connector
40 IE1
BR–Y
BR–R
B
R
9 BD1
31
MPX1
1
T5
Theft Deterrent
ECU
MPX2
100
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B8
Back Door
ECU
Multiplex Communication System Includes Following Systems
∗ Automatic Light Control
∗ Door Lock Control
∗ Front Fog Light
∗ Garage Door Opener
∗ Headlight
∗ Interior Light
∗ Key Reminder
∗ Light Auto Turn Off System
∗ Mirror Heater
∗ Power Window
∗ Rear Window Defogger
∗ Rear Wiper and Washer
∗ Seat Belt Warning
∗ Theft Deterrent
∗ Wireless Door Lock Control
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
B4
A
36
B8
40
B6
C
36
J19
38
Code
T5
See Page
39
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
101
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – CAN Bus
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH
CANL
CANH
LG
CANL
34
L
CANH
33
V
CANL
14
P
6
R
2
W
3
E7
Engine Control Module
1 B
2 B
1 D
2 D
1 E
2 E
W
2 A
11 IC2
22 IC2
11
11
25
CANL
CANH
CANL
J47(A), J48(B), J49(C),
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
1 F
W–B
W
Y
1 A
B
2 C
B
1 C
B
ST–Plug
3
CANH
S11
Steering Sensor
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
IH
102
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
System Outline
CAN has two lines as a pair which make communication with operating voltage. CAN has excellent data speed and error
detecting capacity. It consists of vehicle control systems such as engine control module, data link connector 3, skid control
ECU with actuator, steering sensor and yaw rate sensor.
This system is working for the following systems:
∗ ABS
∗ Auto LSD
∗ Cruise Control
∗ Downhill Assist Control
∗ Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
∗ Engine Control
∗ Hill–Start Assist Control
∗ TRAC
∗ VSC
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
D1
E7
Code
See Page
37
J49
C
38
37
J50
D
38
J47
A
38
J51
E
38
J48
B
38
J52
F
38
Code
S11
S28
Y1
See Page
39
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
39
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
IC2
See Page
46
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: Ground Points
Code
IH
See Page
46
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace LH
103
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
(BAT)
(BAT)
50A
J/B
(ACC)
20A
DR/LCK
(IG)
7. 5A
ACC
15A
RR
WSH
WIG
1
ACC
22
BDR1
12
CLTB
6 C
CLTE
21 C
CLTS
4 C
2
G–W
Y
3 IG1
2 IG1
1 IG1
Y
L–W
9 1E
G–W
2
L–Y
2
L–Y
2
G–W
1
3
4
CLTB
CLTE
CLTS
A39
Automatic Light
Control Sensor
L–W
104
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
TRLY
HRLY
18
17
2
5
1
R–B
R–B
TAIL Relay
3
HF2
20 C
2
2
1
1
1
1
8 1B
10A
HEAD
(LO LH)
10A
HEAD
(LO RH)
10A
HEAD
(HI LH)
10A
HEAD
(HI RH)
W
W
L–W
1 1C
2
19 IC4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
R–L
2
R–W
H1
Headlight LH (High)
R–B
2
W–B
H4
Headlight RH (Low)
R–Y
2
W–B
H2
Headlight LH (Low)
R–W
1
2
R–W
R–L
R–G
R–G
23 IC4
R–B
R–B
W
2
22 IC4
2
3
HEAD
Relay
1
R–L
5
R–W
R–G
2
B
W–B
W–B
Battery
W–B
W
L–W
EB
105
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
3 C
7 C
G–O
R–W
10 IH1
9 IH1
G–O
16
12
R–L
2
IC3
W–B
(∗1)
W–B
W–B
G
8 IH1
R
G–R
1 IH1
TAIL
C12
Combination SW
10
13
14
8
W–B
HF
8 C
R–W
A
1 C
G
HEAD
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
∗ 3 : w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
R
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
2
J15(B)
Junction
Connector
Light
Control SW
OFF
A B
Tail
Head
A B
Auto
W–B
High
Flash
OFF
G–R
ON
LH
RH
11
17
7
1
G–B
Dimmer SW
Fog
Light
SW
Low
R–G
R–G
1
Turn
SW
2
H3
Headlight RH (High)
R–W
3
(∗1)
D B
R–G
E A
R–G
E A
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
E A
R–G
R–G
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
R–G
(∗1)
10 IN1
B A
R–L
G–Y(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
B B
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
IG
106
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J5
Junction
Connector
W–B
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
GND2
PWS
1
2
2
LG
W
3
2 1F 25 1J
8 1A
1 1H
1 1A
W
2
7 1A
(∗2)
5
(∗2)
30A
POWER
2
2 1H
W
W(∗3)
(∗2)
W(∗3)
W(∗2)
W(∗3)
FR FOG
Relay
W
W(∗3)
W–B
L
W
L–O
5
(∗2)
W(∗2)
2
L–O
2
13
(BAT)
15A
FR FOG
2
ILE
4
POWER Relay
(BAT)
R–L
GND1
16
21
2
3
2 A (∗2)
2 B (∗3)
3 A
3 B
1 A (∗2)
1 B (∗3)
L2
Luggage Compartment
Light
DOOR
ON
OFF
G
G–R
I20(A), (B)
Interior Light
G
12 IC3
2
DOOR
2
PWS
ON
OFF
G
3
M5
Moon Roof
Control ECU
4
1
1
W(∗2)
(∗2)
W
1
W(∗3)
1
W–B
W–B
W–B
B
2
F2
Front Fog Light RH
G
G
F1
Front Fog Light LH
J3
Junction
Connector
B
W–B
W(∗3)
W(∗2)
W(∗3)
2
W
L–O
L–O
W–B
G–Y(∗1)
G–Y(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
G
EA
107
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
3
PCYL
25 A
RCYL
22 B
B–Y
Y–R
L–R
DOWN
Y
W
6
COM
19 B
9 1K
(w/ Vanity Light)
18 1A
W–B
12 1A
BUP
10 B
B–L
BDN
8 B
9 IP1
8 BB1
1
UP
E
1
I17
Ignition Key
Cylinder Light
V7
Vanity
Light RH
B
2
B1
Back Door Power
Window Control SW
6
1
J35
Junction Connector
2
2
W
2
1
2
9 1A
6 1E
R
A A
R
H
9 BB1
R
R
R
19 1A
H
H
(Limited)
R
H
A A
4 1A
1 IP2
C B
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
W
(w/ Vanity Light)
R
(w/ Vanity Light)
R
R
5
V6
Vanity Light LH
P7
Personal Light
E
D9
Door Courtesy Light
Front RH
Y
(w/ Vanity Light)
1
R–G
1
D11
Door Courtesy Light
Rear RH
L–R
W
W(∗2)
R–W
R
22 1J
(Limited)
E
R
J6
Junction Connector
E
W(∗3)
W
W
L–O
L–O
L–O
L–O
W–B
W–B
G–Y(∗1)
G–Y(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–W
W–B
G
G
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
∗ 3 : w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
108
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
4 IO3
R
R
E
3 IE1
J6
Junction Connector
R
2 BL1
13 IA1
9 BA1
R
1
2
D10
Door Courtesy Light
Rear LH
P–G
D8
Door Courtesy Light
Front LH
Y–G
9 IA1
8 BA1
4 IE1
4
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
2
E
E
DEFOG Relay
C A
5
1
3
2
2
2
R
140A
ALT
R
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
P–G
W–G
DCYL
B–R
W–R
W–R
(Limited)
26 A
W–B
5 IO3
(Limited)
C A
(Limited)
W–R
(Limited)
W–R
(Limited)
C B
W–R
(Limited)
(Limited)
LP
R
(Limited)
W–R
(Limited)
6 B
R
(Limited)
1 BL1
W–R
(Limited)
1
(Limited)
2
S34
Step Light Rear LH
W–R
R
(Limited)
1
R
2 BM1
S32
Step Light Front LH
W–R
R
(Limited)
2
(Limited)
R
(Limited)
2
(Limited)
R
1 BM1
R
(Limited)
1
(Limited)
2
S35
Step Light Rear RH
W–R
R
(Limited)
1
(Limited)
S33
Step Light Front RH
W–R
R
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
21 B
LCYL
RDEF
6
(BAT)
3 1B
2
2
2
Y–R
W
W
L–O
L–O
L–O
L–O
W–B
B–R
G–Y(∗1)
G–Y(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
G–B(∗1)
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–W
R–W
W–B
W–B
G
G
109
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
STPI
HAZ
3
8
24 1E
14 1J
(BAT)
(IG)
(BAT)
W
(∗4)
2
W
2
IF1
A
(∗1)
2
3
(∗1)
(∗1)
R–B
42 IC4
F5
Front Turn
Signal Light LH
G–B
3
R–B
(∗1)
R–Y
(∗1)
1 IN1
(∗1)
2
2 IH1
F6
Front Turn
Signal Light RH
G–Y
2
3 IH1
LG
2
TFL
4
R–Y
B
E
TFR
2
G–B
2
TSL
7
(∗1)
J4
Junction
Connector
J4
Junction
Connector
E
TSR
G–B
3
4
B
HAZ
8
(∗1)
1
10
B
G–Y
5
STOP LP CTRL
Relay
G–Y
2
EHW
D2
Daytime Running Light Relay
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
6
A
(∗1)
Y–R
S12
Stop Light SW
2
1
E
Y–R
J1
Junction
Connector
D
Y–R
2
(∗1)
G–W
20 IC4
B–Y
E
G–Y
E
J7
Junction Connector
D
Y–R
Y–R
G–B
G–W
Y–R
8
2
B–Y
8 1J
T9
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
20 1E
2
W
10
(∗1)
15A
TRN–HAZ
(∗4)
15A
IG1
10A
STOP
2
Y–R
Y–R
W
W
L–O
L–O
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
G–B(∗1)
W–B
W–B
G–Y(∗1)
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–W
R–W
W–B
G
G
110
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
P
DEFSW
P
C A
G–B
GND
7
B
1
B 3F
A 3C
PBEW
3
DIND
SIND
12
GR–G
B 3F
B 3F
A 3C
R
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
Y–R
E A
J25
Junction Connector
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction Connector
D B
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
IG+
2
R
E A
W–B
E A
Y–R
C
LG
G–B
J35
Junction
Connector
(∗1)
W–B
(∗1)
Y–R
(∗1)
H A
W–B
Y–R
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction Connector
9
F B
H A
C
DFSW
Y–R
E
2 IM1
Y–R
IG
1
D2
Daytime Running Light Relay
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
8 IM1
DRL
D3
Defogger SW
Passenger Seat Belt
Warning Light
Security Indicator Light
G–B
Y–R
G–B
6
12
11
C B
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
(∗1)
LG–R
2
4
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
G–B
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 4 : w/o Daytime Running Light
DIND
5 B
G
1 B
17 B
G–R
DRL
7 A
Y–R
LG
W
W
L–O
L–O
L–O
B–R
G
L–O
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–W
R–W
A
A
W–B
IG
J37
Junction
Connector
G
J5
Junction
Connector
R
A
A
W–B
IK
111
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
10A
SECU/HORN
A B
G–Y
1
12
+B2
SH–
E A
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
BR–Y
31
KSW
MPX1
B A
IG
T5
Theft Deterrent ECU
10
HORN
5
B 3E
A 3D
B 3E
G–Y
A 3D
J12(A)
Junction
Connector
P–G
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
W–R
6 IC3
+B1
2
C B
W–B
P–G
GR–G
GR–G
E
29
G–R
DSWH
34
B–R
IND
25
2
E3
Engine Hood
Courtesy SW
1
G A
G A
G A
D A
D A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
T1
Theft Deterrent
Horn
BR–B
3
1
B–R
B B
K3
Unlock Warning SW
W–L
10 1K
28 1J
BR–Y
BR–B
2 IN1
B–R
B B
G–Y
G–Y
10A
ECU–IG
8 1F
A B
(BAT)
BR–B
(IG)
MPX3
26 C
BR–Y
KSW
14 C
G–Y
SIG
10
1
B–R
W–B
B–R
B–R
W–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
G–R
4
B–R
LG
LG
W
W
B–R
L–O
L–O
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–R
R–W
R–W
R
R
A
W–B
J24
Junction
Connector
A
II
112
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
TOUT
6 A
10A
HORN
L
2
P9
Power Window Control
SW Front RH
G–R
(Except Limited)
(BAT)
W–G
2
10 1E
3
1
3
13 1K
1 1D
2
R
2
5
R–B
5
B
4
1
P13
Power Window Motor
Front RH
L–B
2
1
M
10 IP2
9 IP2
5 IP2
HORN
Relay
W
L–Y
L–R
L–Y
G–R
G–R
C
W
C
W
J7
Junction Connector
C
C
W
GR–B
1
C
1
H9
Horn
(High)
H10
Horn
(Low)
J33
Junction
Connector
C
W
W
B B
C A
GR–B
C A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
C
W
B–R
B–R
LG
LG
W
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
R–W
R–W
R
R
113
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
RRD
G
7 BB1
6 BB1
G
L–B
L
5
2
1
3
L–Y
M
1
R
G–B
2
BW
7
12 IA1
2 IA2
L–O
R–L
10 IA2
11
B
B
11 IA2
5 IA2
B2
16
B–R
RRU
18
P15
Power Window Motor
Rear RH
B
6
G–B
12 IA2
PU
13
W
7 IA2
PD
15
B
L–R
A A
L–R
L–Y
B A
D17
Door Lock Control SW Front LH
Power Window Master SW
R–B
L–Y
C B
R
L–R
B A
L–Y
L–R
A A
B B
R–B
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
W/L 2
22 C
R
W/L 1
24 C
W
W
5
BB1
W
4
P11
Power Window Control
SW Rear RH
W
W
W
B–R
LG
LG
B–R
B–R
L–O
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
R–W
R–W
R
R
114
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
5
2
1
3
E
2
1
1
2
4
5
3
6
D
U
SSRB
PLS
PLS2
E
UL
L
8
5
R–W
GND
W–B
PLS2
17
BR–B
PLS
14
W–G
3
W–R
VCC
G–W
1
DU
4
W–L
M
P14
Power Window Motor
Rear LH
6 BA1
2
L
G
G–R
7 BA1
G–R
L
G–W
6 IA2
G–W
9 IA2
DD
9
L
RLD
10
L–B
RLU
12
L–B
D17
Door Lock Control SW Front LH
Power Window Master SW
5 IA1
4 IA1
L–W
L–O
W
4
P10
Power Window Control
SW Rear LH
B
J38
Junction
Connector
M
P12
Power Window Motor Front LH
B
B
W–B
W–B
B
5 BA1
W
R
LG
LG
W–B
4 IA2
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
R–W
R–W
R
A
A
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
115
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
LSWD
ACTD
21 A
10 A
L–B
D
UL3
12 A
W–R
L–O
A
L2
20
G
L–W
1 1K
LSWP
30 A
3 1K
D18
Door Lock Control SW
Front RH
Lock
8 IA1
7 IA1
13 IA2
8 IA2
L
G
W
B–R
B–W
5 IP1
9
10
8
1
4
6 IA1
W–B
W–B
L–O
6 IP1
3
W–B
6
L
5
L–R
L–W
D
R
A
Unlock
B–W
L–O
D
L–O
L–W
A
5 1K
L–W
J6
Junction
Connector
UL1
15
L
L1
19
M
L–W
4 IP2
7
W–B
L–O
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Lock Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor Front LH
W–B
W–B
W–B
R
R
LG
LG
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
R–W
R–W
A
A
IK
J37
Junction
Connector
116
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
ACT–
LSR
24
5
9 1L
18 1L
6 1L
16 1L
ACTY
20 B
23 1L
11 1L
15 1K
22 1L
10 1L
R–G
ACT+
23
12 IC5
B–W
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
7 IP2
2 IP2
10 BA1
11 BA1
12 BA1
10 BB1
11 BB1
12 BB1
B–R
B–W
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
7
1
4
6
1
4
6
1
4
R–G
L–B
7 IP1
B
L–R
4
W–B
9
D20
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear LH
Door Lock Motor
Rear LH
9
4 BA1
4 BB1
W–B
W–B
D19
Door Lock Detection
SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor
Front RH
M
W–B
W–B
8
M
W–B
M
D21
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear RH
Door Lock Motor
Rear RH
DOOR
S15
Suspension
Control ECU
W–B
R
LG
LG
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
W–B
R
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
R–W
R–W
W–B
117
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
10 1B
6 1B
RDA
4 B
PRG
LMRY
3 B
3 A
(IG)
L–R
G–O
R
Y–B
P–B
D
38 IE1
39 IE1
41 IE1
D
J7
Junction Connector
D
R
7
R
BZR2
R
BZR
9
10 IC4
1 IC3
7. 5A
GAUGE
1
W3
Wireless Door
Lock Buzzer
(BAT)
2
5
+B
R
3
PRG
R
R
2
RDA
L–R
G–O
4 1G
10A
DOME
2
2
R
E
1
D7
Door Control
Receiver
R
2
W–B
2
W–B
W–B
A B
A A
2
DOME
Relay
3
R–L
1
2
2
R–W
A A
W–B
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
5
R
R
LG
LG
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
R
R
G
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–W
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
R–W
W–B
W–B
W–B
BO
118
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
DRLP
DCY2
12 C
11 C
SPD
KSWO
15 C
14
∗ 5 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 6 : 1GR–FE
H A
H A
R
R
F B
BR
13 C
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
R–L
Head (USA)
13 D
R–G
V–R
12 D
G
10 D
18 B
LG
Speedometer
16 C
R
15 C
Beam
5 B
R–W
19 B
Front Fog
V–G
8 C
Driver' s
Seat Belt
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
Door
17 A
W–L
V–Y
1 1G
7 IM1
(∗6)
BR
BR
LG
(∗5)
R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
R
G
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
R–G
(∗6)
W–R
BR
W–R
BR
W–B
(∗5)
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
ED
EE
119
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
B16(A), (B)
Buckle SW RH
1 A
1 B
2 A (∗11)
2 B (∗12)
L
S28
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
GR
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
SP1
FSR+
4
8
W
FSR–
4 BI1
1 BI1
7 IC2
4 B
A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
L–R
G–Y
GR–R
2 D
10 E
FSR–
W
13 B
9
BSW
B
12 B
5
BGND
B
GR–R
Buzzer
O3
Occupant
Classification ECU
12
1 D (∗7)
3 E (∗8)
FSR+
PBEW
2 C
L–R
G–Y
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
120
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
DBKL
13 A
G–Y
B–R
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
B B
2
E 7(D)
Engine Control
Module
1
D A
ELS2(∗5)
ELS1(∗6)
12 D (∗5)
13 D (∗6)
G–Y
B
Y–G
R21(A), R22(B)
Rear Window Defogger
2
10A
MIR HEATER
2
I A
36 IE1
B–L
D B
2
4 BD1
Y–G
(∗9)
(∗10)
G–Y
1 B
30A
DEFOG
7 BH1
Y–G
L
K B
L
C A
10 BK1
1
2
(∗9)
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
D A
1 A
(∗10)
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
Y–G
26 IE1
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
D A
18 IC4
4 IC4
Y–G
Y–G
D A
D A
D A
(∗6)
(∗5)
Y–G
W–B
B–R
B15
Buckle SW LH
3
Y–G
B–L
C B
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction Connector
4
W–B
E B
A B
G–Y
A A
J53
Junction Connector
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
(∗10)
(∗9)
B
∗ 5 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 6 : 1GR–FE
∗ 7 : w/ Side Airbag
∗ 8 : w/o Side Airbag
∗ 9 : w/ Driving Position Memory
∗10 : w/o Driving Position Memory
∗11 : w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
∗12 : w/o Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
(∗9)
W–B
W–B
W–B
L–O
W–B
L–O
3 BH1
(∗10)
W–B
B–R
1 BK1
W–B
W–R
W–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
10
BD1
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
(∗9)
BL
121
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
PKB
17 C
4 1L
12 1F
10A
ECU–B
G B
17 1J
A A
GR
18 IA1
R–Y
B–L
18 IP1
G A
E B
1 1E
LG
B–L
B–L
2
W–R
2
B
W–R
B
W–R
B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
4 1B
GR
(BAT)
J6
Junction Connector
L
14 A
R–Y
11
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
LG
OBD2
BECU
2 B
W–B
7
GR
SIL
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
1 EA1 (∗5)
3 EA2 (∗6)
GR
5
P4
Parking Brake SW
G–B
5
W–B
4
M3
Mirror Heater LH
4
B–L
M4
Mirror Heater RH
G–B
6 IC4
1
4
L
G2
Generator
W–B
W–B
W–R
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
W–B
W–B
W–R
W–B
W–B
122
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
Rear Wiper and
Washer SW
A B
C A
C A
C14
Combination SW
B B
LG–B
12
HI
2
7 IH1
1
W–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
P–L
BR–R
R–Y
P–B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
F A
PCTY
11 B
RLCY
1
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
3 IC3
H B
24 B
P–L
B A
DCTY
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
B A
23 B
P–B
2
RWINT
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
R–B
RWON
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
R–B
D24
Diode
(Rear Wiper)
9 C
BR–W
1 1B
10 C
GR–R
2
BR–W
1
GR–R
B–O
WMTR
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction Connector
M
GR–R
4
LG–B
LG–B
3
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction Connector
LG–B
W2
Washer Motor
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
12 B
RRCY
23 A
MPX2
37 IE1
6 IO3
40 IE1
BR–R
10
Washer
OFF
LO
∗ 5 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 6 : 1GR–FE
Washer
13
W–R
W–R
B–R
B–R
L–O
L–O
W–B
W–B
123
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
J39
Junction
Connector
F
E
F
E
2
14 B
L–R
ACT–
15 B
L–B
ACT+
21 B
B–R
LSE
8 B
BR–W
POS
7 B
G–Y
FULL
6 B
R–G
HALF
5 B
V–Y
UP
4 B
GR–R
DOWN
19 B
LG–B
1
BR–R
E
B10
Back Door Opener SW
LG–R
HSW–
22 B
L–O
B–R
W–R
9 BD1 7 BD1 5 BD1 6 BD1
HSW+
10 B
V–W
W–B
GND
3 A
L
BDR
4 A
B
SIG
6 A
L–R
BECU
5 A
R
MPX2
1 A
3
2
1
5
6
4
3
1
2
M
T10
Tailgate Control SW
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
Back Door Lock Detection SW
Back Door Lock Motor
W–R
B–R
L–O
W–B
124
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
P
W
18 B
12 B
3 B
2 B
1 B
G–R
P–B
BR–B
Y–G
R–G
IC–
23 B
L–W
IC1
16 B
B–O
IC2
17 B
W–R
IC+
11 B
Y–G
R–B
BDDN
25 B
Y–B
BDUP
13 B
1
3
5
4
4
5
1
2
6
3
R
G
SSRB
PLS
PLS2
E
SGND
WIP+
WIP–
Return
Position
Furthest
Position
M
Stop
M
2
R23
Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Position SW
B11
Back Door Power Window Motor
125
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
System Outline
Communication Outline
Communication is made among the body, theft deterrent and back door ECUs.
When the ECU receives a signal from related switches, i.e., the rear wiper SW, the body ECU sends signals to the back door
ECU, and moves rear wiper.
For details, please refer to the new car features and/or the repair manual.
126
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Parts Location
Code
See Page
A32
C
36
A33
D
36
A34
E
36
A39
36
B1
36
B4
A
36
B5
B
36
C
36
B6
B7
Code
F5
F6
A
40
B9
B
40
B10
40
B11
40
B15
H4
43 (*2)
A
B16
B
42 (*1)
42 (*1)
C8
A
37
C9
B
37
C10
C
37
C11
D
37
40
32 (2UZ–FE)
J40
A
40
34 (1GR–FE)
J41
B
40
J43
A
J44
B
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
32 (2UZ–FE)
J53
42 (*1)
34 (1GR–FE)
K3
39
32 (2UZ–FE)
L2
40
34 (1GR–FE)
M3
41
32 (2UZ–FE)
M4
41
34 (1GR–FE)
M5
41
42 (*1)
O3
32 (2UZ–FE)
43 (*2)
33 (2UZ–FE)
P1
34 (1GR–FE)
I17
I20
40
J39
34 (1GR–FE)
H10
43 (*2)
J38
34 (1GR–FE)
32 (2UZ–FE)
H9
43 (*2)
32 (2UZ–FE)
34 (1GR–FE)
H3
42 (*1)
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
H2
See Page
J37
34 (1GR–FE)
H1
Code
34 (1GR–FE)
32 (2UZ–FE)
G2
40
B8
See Page
F2
35 (1GR–FE)
37
P4
39
A
40
P7
41
B
40
P9
41
33 (2UZ–FE)
P10
41
35 (1GR–FE)
P11
41
33 (2UZ–FE)
P12
41
35 (1GR–FE)
P13
41
41
J1
C12
37
C14
37
D1
37
D2
37
J4
38
P14
D3
37
J5
38
P15
D7
40
J6
38
R21
A
41
D8
40
J7
38
R22
B
41
D9
40
D10
D11
J3
41
J8
A
38
R23
41
40
J9
B
38
S12
39
40
J10
A
38
S15
39
D12
40
J11
B
38
D13
40
J12
A
38
D14
40
J13
B
38
S32
41
D15
40
J14
A
38
S33
41
D16
40
J15
B
38
S34
41
D17
40
J18
A
38
S35
41
D18
40
J19
B
38
D19
40
J20
A
38
D20
40
J21
B
38
T5
39
D21
40
J22
A
38
T9
39
D24
37
J23
B
38
T10
41
E3
E7
D
F1
F2
* 1 : Power Seat
S28
T1
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
32 (2UZ–FE)
J24
38
V6
41
34 (1GR–FE)
J25
38
V7
41
37
J31
32 (2UZ–FE)
J32
A
38
B
38
34 (1GR–FE)
J33
38
32 (2UZ–FE)
J35
38
W2
W3
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
33 (2UZ–FE)
35 (1GR–FE)
* 2 : Manual Seat
127
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Multiplex Communication System – BEAN
: Relay Blocks
Code
2
See Page
22
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Floor No.2 Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
1G
1H
1J
1K
1L
3C
3D
3E
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
EA1
44 (2UZ–FE)
EA2
45 (1GR–FE)
IA1
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine No.2 Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room R/B)
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Relay Wire (Behind the Instrument Panel J/B)
IG1
46
Instrument Panel No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IH1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Behind the Combination Meter)
IM1
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BH1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Back Door No.2 Wire (Left Side of Back Door)
IA2
IC2
IC3
IC4
IC5
IP1
IP2
BI1
50 (*1)
51 (*2)
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Front RH Seat)
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
BL1
48
Floor No.2 Wire and Step Rear Floor LH Wire (Near the Side Step LH)
BM1
48
Floor Wire and Step Rear Floor RH Wire (Near the Side Step RH)
* 1 : Power Seat
* 2 : Manual Seat
128
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
ED
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
II
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
EE
129
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I GROUND POINT
W–B
B
(2UZ–FE)
STA Relay
2
IG Relay
2
ER
2
HEATER Relay
2
(2UZ–FE)
EC
W–B
W–B
W–B
Air Switching
Valve
W–B
W–B
EQ
DEFOG Relay
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 1)
Air Pump
(2UZ–FE)
W–B
W–B
W–B
B B
B B
B B
B B
B B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
2
A/F HEATER Relay
2
BATT CHG Relay
3
B A
B A
B A
W–B
W–B
Front Parking
Light LH
W–B
Engine Hood
Courtesy SW
W–B
EFI Relay
B A
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
AIR SUS Relay
4
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
(MOD2)
W–B
W–B
A B
A B
A A
A B
A A
A B
(GND3)
(EXI3)
Skid Control
ECU with
Actuator
(GND1)
(GND2)
Front Turn Signal
Light RH
A B
A A
W–B
W–B
W–B
Brake Fluid Level
Warning SW
Front Turn Signal
Light LH
W–B
A A
W–B
Headlight LH (Low)
Front Fog Light LH
Front Fog Light RH
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Washer Level Sensor
Headlight RH (Low)
W–B
W–B
(GND2)
W–B
W–B
W–B
EB
368
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–B
(GND)
Suspension
Control
ECU
W–B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
(MOD1)
(2UZ–FE)
Front Wiper Motor
EA
Front Parking
Light RH
I
(GND)
(GND)
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
W–B
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
W–B
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
W–B
Transfer
Shift
Actuator
W–B
W–B
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 7
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
W–B
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 8
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
W–B
W–B
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 2)
(E01)
(E02)
(4WD)
(E1)
(E03)
(E04)
(E05)
W–B
10
IM2
BR
BR
7
IM1
BR
W–B
W–B(4WD)
W–B
ED
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
W–B
E
B
A
A
(2UZ–FE)
BR
4
IN1
A
A
BR
BR
W–B
9
IE1
W–B
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
W–B
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
16 IM2
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
W–B
9 IM2
BR
BR
ED
W–B
J28
Junction
Connector
5
EC1
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
(ME01)
(E05)
(E04)
10
IM2
BR
9
IM2
BR
7
IM1
BR
BR
W–B
BR
BR
W–B
(E03)
Air Injection
Control Driver
(SG)
Data Link
Connector 3
Canister Pump Module
(ME01) Engine
Control Module
(ECC)
Combination SW
(SG)
Data Link
Connector 3
(ET)
Combination
Meter
E
W–B
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 1)
E
BR
(GND)
Combination
Meter
(2UZ–FE)
BR
(GND)
(ET)
(2UZ–FE)
BR
W–B
Transfer Shift
Actuator
Combination SW
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
ADD Actuator
(ECC)
W–B
EE
Engine
Control
Module
BR
BR
W–B
Engine
Control
Module
W–B
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
BR
(E01)
(E02)
Engine
Control
Module
(E1)
W–B
EE
(1GR–FE)
W–B
W–B
W–B
EF
17
IM2
W–B
9
IE1
W–B
Canister Pump Module
(1GR–FE)
369
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I GROUND POINT
Door Control
Receiver
W–B
Rear Combination
Light RH
W–B
Rear Combination
Light LH
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A A
A A
A A
A A
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A A
License Plate Light
Back Door ECU
W–B
10 BD1
W–B
Power Outlet (Rear)
3
BH1
W–B
Rear Window Defogger
High Mounted
Stop Light
1
BF1
W
Trailer Socket
A A
BO
A B
A B
A B
W–B
B
(∗3)
B
W–B
(∗3)
W–B
1
BK1
W–B
B
B
(∗3)
(∗3)
W–B
B
(∗4)
B
A/C Control
Assembly
(VER1)
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
A B
A B
(∗4)
A B
(∗4)
A B
A B
W–B
B
3F
Buckle SW LH
A A
W–B
W–B
Position Control ECU
and SW
W–B
(∗4)
B
3F
Seat Heater LH
(E)
Lumbar Support
Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
B
3F
B
3F
W–B
(E)
B
3F
B
3F
W–B
Seat Heater LH
Power Seat Control
SW (Driver' s Seat)
W–B
W–B
W–B
5
IR1
Buckle SW LH
W–B
Cigarette Lighter
W–B
W–B
B
3F
B
3F
(2UZ–FE)
Shift Lock
Control ECU
Glove Box Light
B
3F
W–B
(GND)
Hazard SW
W–B
(4WD)
Defogger SW
Heater Control Panel
Security Indicator
Light
Power Outlet (Front)
B
3F
W–B
Downhill Assist
Control SW
W–B
(E)
Lumbar Support
Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
J53
Junction
Connector
(∗4)
Seat Heater SW LH
W–B
(∗3)
W–B
Seat Heater SW RH
W–B
W–B
(∗3)
BL
B
3F
W–B
(E)
(∗4)
Towing Converter
Relay
W–B
(∗3)
W–B
Voltage Inverter
W–B
W–B
Fuel Pump
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
A B
W–B
W–B
Yaw Rate Sensor
A
Theft Deterrent ECU
4WD Control SW
Height Control Mode
Select SW
W–B
A
A
W–B
W–B
A
A
W–B
W–B
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
370
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Blower Motor
Controller
Height Control SW
W–B
I
: w/ Daytime Running Light
: w/o Daytime Running Light
: w/ Driving Position Memory
: w/o Driving Position Memory
Data Link
Connector 3
(CG)
W–B
W–B
1
2
3
4
W–B E
A
W–B
Remote Control
Mirror SW
W–B
Door Lock Control SW
Front LH
Power Window
Master SW
W–B
B
B
A
4
IA2
W–B
A W–B E
A
W–B A
W–B
W–B
Seat Memory SW
(∗3)
W–B
(∗2)
9
IF1
W–B
(∗2)
(∗1)
J5
Junction
Connector
B
B
2
1H
W–B
A
IG
4
BA1
14
1A
W–B
6
1A
W–B
15
1A
W–B
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear LH
W–B
W–B
13
1A
W–B
Door Lock Detection
SW Front RH
W–B
W–B
12
1A
A
Door Lock Control
SW Front RH
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
Daytime Running
Light Relay
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
W–B
A
Mirror Heater LH
D
B
W–B
J38
Junction
Connector
B
W–B A
Door Key Lock and
Unlock SW Front LH
Door Lock Detection
SW Front LH
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction Connector
D
B
W–B
∗
∗
∗
∗
4
IP2
W–B
W–B
A
Inner Mirror
(E2)
Moon Roof
Control ECU
(E)
(E)
(E)
Personal Light
Moon Roof
Control SW
POWER Relay
W–B
Mirror Heater RH
4
BB1
W–B
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear RH
W–B
W–B
A
W–B
A
J37
Junction
Connector
DC SKT Relay
A
B
A
A
Engine Control
Module
W–B
A
B
A
A
W–B
A
B
A
A
W–B
1
IM2
W–B
(EC)
(2UZ–FE)
W–B
W
W
W–B
W
W–B
(2UZ–FE)
W–B
3
BI1
W–B
W–B
W–B
(6 Speaker)
Occupant
Classification ECU
W
(6 Speaker)
A
W–B
W–B
Vanity Light LH
A
1 IO3
Transponder Key
Computer
W
7 1A
W–B
Engine
Control Module
18
1A
IK
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
4WD Control ECU
Body ECU
(GND2)
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
(EOM)
(GND1)
A B
A B
Vanity Light RH
Luggage Compartment
Light
Interior Light
Seat Heater RH
Buckle SW RH
Power Seat
Control SW
(Front Passenger' s
Seat)
A B
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
BR
W–B
W–B
BM
BR
(GND)
(GND2)
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
BP
371
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I GROUND POINT
A
B
W–B
A
B
W–B
Steering Sensor
A
A
W–B
A
A
W–B
A
A
W–B
A
A
W–B
A
A
W–B
Key Interlock
Solenoid
A
B
Combination SW
(EW)
Combination SW
(EL)
(E1)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
(E2)
Diff. Lock SW
Rheostat
Towing Brake
Controller
W–B
Auto LSD SW
(2WD)
A
A
W–B
Roll Sensing of
Curtain Shield
Airbag Cutoff SW
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
Unlock Warning SW
W–B
W–B
(TB) Combination SW
W–B
W–B
BR
(∗6)
W–B
BR
A
3B
24
BJ1
LG
13
ID1
BR
BR
(∗5)
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
with Display
A 3B
BR
Rear Seat Audio
Controller
W–B
Main SW
Junction Connector
W–B
∗ 5 : w/ Navigation System
∗ 6 : w/o Navigation System
IH
Low Pressure
Tank Valve
W–B
W–B
Height Control
Valve
W–B
W–B
Height Control
Compressor
W–B
Height Control Motor
IJ
BN
372
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I
: Parts Location
Code
J2
See Page
A
J3
Code
33 (2UZ–FE)
B
J5
See Page
J28
38
35 (1GR–FE)
J33
A
38
33 (2UZ–FE)
J34
B
38
35 (1GR–FE)
J35
A
38
38
J36
B
38
J14
A
38
J37
38
J15
B
38
J38
40
J22
A
38
J40
A
40
J23
B
38
J41
B
40
38
J43
A
42 (*1)
J24
Code
See Page
J43
A
J44
B
J45
A
J46
B
J53
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
43 (*2)
42 (*1)
: Relay Blocks
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
2
22
Engine Room R/B (Engine Compartment Left)
3
23
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Engine Compartment Left)
4
23
Engine Room R/B No.4 (Engine Compartment Left)
: Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
24
Roof Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
25
Instrument Panel Wire and Driver Side J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
28
Instrument Panel Wire and Center J/B (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
3B
3F
: Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EC1
45 (1GR–FE)
Engine Wire and Differential Wire (Near the Front Differential)
IA2
46
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
ID1
46
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
46
Instrument Panel Wire and Relay Wire (Behind the Instrument Panel J/B)
47
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Side of Blower Unit)
IM1
IM2
IN1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IO3
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Floor Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IP2
47
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IR1
47
Instrument Panel Wire and Cigarette Lighter Wiring Assembly (Rear Console)
BA1
48
Rear Door No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Center Pillar)
BB1
48
Rear Door No.1 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Center Pillar)
BD1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Left Rear Side of Roof)
BF1
48
Frame No.3 Wire and Floor No.2 Wire (Rear Side of Side Frame LH)
BH1
48
Back Door No.1 Wire and Back Door No.2 Wire (Left Side of Back Door)
BI1
50 (*1)
51 (*2)
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Front RH Seat)
BJ1
48
Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly and Radio Installation Wiring Sub Assembly (Center of Roof)
BK1
50 (*1)
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front LH Seat)
* 1 : Power Seat
* 2 : Manual Seat
373
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I GROUND POINT
: Ground Points
Code
EA
EB
See Page
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
44 (2UZ–FE)
45 (1GR–FE)
Ground Points Location
Front Right Fender
Front Left Fender
EC
44 (2UZ–FE)
Right Bank Cylinder Head
ED
44 (2UZ–FE)
Left Bank Cylinder Head
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Cylinder Block
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Right Bank Cylinder Block
EF
45 (1GR–FE)
Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block
EQ
44 (2UZ–FE)
Near the Starter
ER
44 (2UZ–FE)
Rear Side of Front Right Fender
IG
46
Left Kick Panel
IH
46
Instrument Panel Brace LH
46
Instrument Panel Brace RH
EE
II
IJ
IK
46
Right Kick Panel
BL
48
Floor Seat Crossmember LH
BM
48
Floor Seat Crossmember RH
BN
48
Near the No.5 Crossmember of Side Frame LH
BO
48
Rear Pillar LH
BP
48
Rear Pillar RH
374
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
375
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
The chart below shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each electrical source
(Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other Parts.
140A ALT
2
60A HEATER
2
HEATER Relay
(Point Side)
2
IG Relay
(Point Side)
2
25A SEAT HEATER
2
DEFOG Relay
(Point Side)
2
50A AIR SUS
2
10A AIRSUS NO.2
50A AM1
2
Ignition SW
(AM1)
50A J/B
2
10A MIR HEATER
2
30A DEFOG
2
I18
10A IGN
Battery
30A AM2
2
Ignition SW
(AM2)
7.5A GAUGE
1
I18
10A SRS
7.5A STA NO.2
20A EFI
2
EFI Relay
(Point Side)
2
10A DOME
Short Pin
2
20A RADIO NO.1
2
10A ECU-B
10A HEAD (HI RH)
HEAD Relay
(Point Side)
10A HEAD (HI LH)
2
2
10A HEAD (LO RH)
10A HEAD (LO LH)
376
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
10A EFI NO.2
2
J
Example
Starter
S1
Parts
7.5A HEATER NO.2
Code or Location
2
4
7.5A DRL
15A IG1
Location
10A ECU-IG
15A RR WSH
Electrical Source
1
20A 4WD
30A FR WIP-WSH
50A A/PUMP
7.5A ACC
30A TOWING BRK
1
10A CIG
30A BATT CHG
40A TOWING
2
10A STOP
TAIL Relay
(Point Side)
15A AC115V INV
1
10A TAIL
1
15A FR FOG
7.5A OBD
10A SECU/HORN
30A P P/SEAT
30A D P/SEAT
1
30A POWER
15A PWR OUTLET
7.5A ALT-S
10A HORN
15A A/F HEATER
15A TRN-HAZ
[LOCATION]
40A ABS MTR
2
30A ABS SOL
1
: Driver Side J/B (See Page 24)
2
: Engine Room R/B (See Page 22)
10A ETCS
20A DR/LCK
30A TOWING
20A RADIO NO.2
377
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Driver Side J/B (See Page 24)
Fuse
7.5A
7.5A
ACC
GAUGE
System
Air Conditioning
Audio System (10 Speaker)
Audio System (6 Speaker)
Automatic Light Control
Door Lock Control
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Headlight
Interior Light
Key Reminder
Light Auto Turn Off System
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
Power Outlet (12V)
Power Window
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
Rear Wiper and Washer
Remote Control Mirror
Seat Belt Warning
Shift Lock
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
Air Conditioning
Audio System (10 Speaker)
Audio System (6 Speaker)
Charging
Combination Meter
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Door Lock Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Interior Light
Key Reminder
Moon Roof
Multi Mode 4WD
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
378
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Page
358
342
348
140
202
84
70
130
154
176
142
104
334
298
192
330
186
294
178
292
222
212
258
268
358
342
348
68
352
252
246
202
238
230
84
70
154
176
288
274
104
J
Fuse
System
Page
GAUGE
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
Seat Belt Warning
SRS
Taillight and Illumination
Tire Pressure Warning System
334
178
281
162
326
7.5A
STA NO.2
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Starting
238
230
84
70
58
10A
CIG
Cigarette Lighter
296
ECU–IG
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
Automatic Light Control
Door Lock Control
Headlight
Interior Light
Key Reminder
Light Auto Turn Off System
Moon Roof
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/ Driving Position Memory)
Power Window
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
Rear Wiper and Washer
Seat Belt Warning
Shift Lock
Theft Deterrent
Tire Pressure Warning System
Wireless Door Lock Control
IGN
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Air Conditioning
Combination Meter
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Engine Immobiliser System
SRS
7.5A
10A
10A
258
268
140
202
130
154
176
142
288
104
308
192
330
186
178
292
222
326
212
258
358
352
252
246
238
230
84
70
98
281
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
379
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Fuse
System
Page
10A
SECU/HORN
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
10A
SRS
SRS
281
TAIL
Combination Meter
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Taillight and Illumination
Trailer Towing
352
84
70
162
322
IG1
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
Air Conditioning
Automatic Glare–Resistant EC Mirror with Compass
Back–Up Light
Charging
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Door Lock Control
Electric Tension Reducer
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Headlight
Multi Mode 4WD
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
Power Outlet (115V)
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/ Driving Position Memory)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
Seat Belt Warning
Seat Heater
SRS
Stop Light
Taillight and Illumination
Trailer Towing
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (w/ Daytime Running Light)
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (w/o Daytime Running Light)
10A
15A
104
222
212
258
268
358
302
174
68
252
246
202
306
238
230
130
274
104
334
300
308
330
178
318
281
170
162
322
146
150
15A
PWR OUTLET
Power Outlet (12V)
298
15A
RR WSH
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Rear Wiper and Washer
104
186
20A
4WD
Multi Mode 4WD
274
30A
D P/SEAT
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/ Driving Position Memory)
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/o Driving Position Memory)
308
312
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
380
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J
Fuse
System
Page
30A
FR WIP–WSH
Front Wiper and Washer
184
30A
P P/SEAT
Power Seat (Front Passenger’s Seat)
316
POWER
Door Lock Control
Moon Roof
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Power Window
Rear Wiper and Washer
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
202
288
104
192
186
222
212
30A
Engine Room R/B (See Page 22)
Fuse
System
Page
7.5A
ALT–S
Charging
68
7.5A
HEATER NO.2
Air Conditioning
358
7.5A
OBD
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
84
70
10A
AIRSUS NO.2
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
268
DOME
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
Air Conditioning
Audio System (10 Speaker)
Audio System (6 Speaker)
Combination Meter
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Door Lock Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Garage Door Opener
Interior Light
Key Reminder
Light Auto Turn Off System
Moon Roof
Multi Mode 4WD
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
Power Window
Rear Wiper and Washer
Seat Belt Warning
10A
258
268
358
342
348
352
252
246
202
238
230
84
70
182
154
176
142
288
274
104
334
192
186
178
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
381
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Fuse
System
Page
DOME
Taillight and Illumination
Theft Deterrent
Tire Pressure Warning System
Wireless Door Lock Control
162
222
326
212
ECU–B
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Air Conditioning
Automatic Light Control
Door Lock Control
Engine Immobiliser System
Headlight
Interior Light
Key Reminder
Light Auto Turn Off System
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/ Driving Position Memory)
Power Window
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
Rear Wiper and Washer
Seat Belt Warning
SRS
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
258
358
140
202
98
130
154
176
142
104
308
192
330
186
178
281
222
212
EFI NO.2
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
238
230
84
70
ETCS
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
252
246
238
230
84
70
10A
HEAD(HI LH)
Front Fog Light
Headlight
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
136
130
104
10A
HEAD(HI RH)
Headlight
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
130
104
10A
HEAD(LO LH)
Headlight
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
130
104
10A
HEAD(LO RH)
Headlight
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
130
104
10A
HORN
Horn
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
304
104
10A
10A
10A
10A
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
382
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J
Fuse
System
Page
10A
HORN
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
222
212
10A
MIR HEATER
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
104
330
10A
STOP
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Shift Lock
Stop Light
Trailer Towing
15A
AC115V INV
Power Outlet (115V)
300
15A
A/F HEATER
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
84
70
15A
FR FOG
Front Fog Light
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
136
104
TRN–HAZ
Headlight
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Trailer Towing
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (w/ Daytime Running Light)
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light (w/o Daytime Running Light)
130
104
322
146
150
DR/LCK
Door Lock Control
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Power Window
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
202
104
192
222
212
EFI
Air Conditioning
Audio System (10 Speaker)
Audio System (6 Speaker)
Cruise Control (1GR–FE)
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1GR–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (2UZ–FE)
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
Remote Control Mirror
358
342
348
252
246
238
230
84
70
15A
20A
20A
258
268
252
246
238
230
84
70
104
292
170
322
334
294
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
383
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Fuse
20A
20A
RADIO NO.1
RADIO NO.2
System
Page
Audio System (10 Speaker)
Audio System (6 Speaker)
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
342
348
Audio System (10 Speaker)
Navigation System, Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) and
Audio System (w/ Navigation System)
342
334
334
25A
SEAT HEATER
Seat Heater
318
30A
ABS SOL
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
258
30A
AM2
Charging
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Ignition (1GR–FE)
Ignition (2UZ–FE)
Starting
68
84
70
64
60
58
30A
BATT CHG
Trailer Towing
322
30A
DEFOG
Engine Control (1GR–FE)
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
84
70
104
330
30A
TOWING
Trailer Towing
322
30A
TOWING BRK
Trailer Towing
322
40A
ABS MTR
ABS, TRAC, VSC, Auto LSD, Downhill Assist Control and
Hill–Start Assist Control
258
40A
TOWING
Trailer Towing
322
50A
AIR SUS
Active Height Control Suspension and
Electric Modulated Air Suspension
268
50A
AM1
Charging
68
50A
A/PUMP
Engine Control (2UZ–FE)
70
50A
J/B
Automatic Light Control
Light Auto Turn Off System
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Taillight and Illumination
Theft Deterrent
Wireless Door Lock Control
140
142
104
162
222
212
60A
HEATER
Air Conditioning
358
ALT
Charging
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
Taillight and Illumination
68
104
330
162
140A
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
384
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Memo
385
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
A1
A2
A9
A10
A11
Black
Gray
Gray
Gray
Black
1 2
1
1
2
2
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6
3
A12
A13
A14
A15
Dark Gray
Dark Gray
Yellow
Yellow
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1
1
2
A16
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
A17
A18
12
1
2
5
A19
A20
A21
Black
Black
Black
12
12
1 2 3
22 23 24 25 26
A22
1 2
6
3 4
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24
A24
A25
A26
A27
A28
Black
Black
Black
Black
Black
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
A29
A30
A31
A32
Black
Yellow
Yellow
Yellow
1 2 3 4 5
1 2
A B
A
B
3 4
1 2 3
5 6 7 8 9 101112
13 1415 16 171819 20
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
386
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A B
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314151617
1819 2021 22 23 2425 26 27 28
K
A33
A34
A36
Yellow
Yellow
Yellow
A B
1 2
A
A38
Black
1
B
1
1 2 3 4
3 4
2
1 2 3 4 5 6
5 6 7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 101112
13 1415 16 171819 20
A39
A37
A40
A41
A42
A43
Black
Black
Blue
Gray
1 2
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4
1
2
A44
A45
A46
A47
A48
Black
Black
Gray
Black
Black
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
A49
1
1
B1
Orange
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2
2
B2
B3
Black
Black
1
2
B4
1
2
3
2
4
B5
1
10
1
2
B6
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
3 4
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
23 24 25 26
17 18 19 20
18 19 20 21
27 28 29 30
21 22 23 24
22 23 24 25 26
387
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
*1 : w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger’s Seat)
*2 : w/o Power Seat (Front Passenger’s Seat)
B7
B8
B9
Blue
12
3
456 7 8
2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112 13
B10
B11
Gray
Black
1
2
1
3
4
3 4 5 6
4 3
14 15 16171819
6 5
B12
B14
Black
Gray
1 2
3 4
1
B17
B15
2
B16
B16
(*1)
(*2) Gray
1
1 2 3 4 5
2
1
C2
C3
C4
Gray
Black
Black
(1GR–FE) Black
1 2
1 2
2
1
3
C4
C5
C6
(2UZ–FE) Dark Gray
C7
2
C8
Gray
1
1
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
2
2
1 2 3 4
111213141516171819 20
C9
C10
C11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516171819 20
111213141516171819 20
111213141516171819 20
C12
1
2
3
4 5 6 7
2
C1
1
1 2 3 4 5
2021222324 25
8
9 10 1112131415 16 17
C13
C14
Black
Black
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 131415 16 17 18
388
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C15
2 1
2
K
C16
C17
Black
Black
D1
Black
D2
1 2
1 2
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 101112
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
D3
D4
D5
Gray
Blue
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
D7
D8
Gray
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
1 2 3 4 5
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
D15
Gray
Gray
Gray
Black
Black
Black
Black
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
D16
2
D17
D18
1
1
2
3
4
1 2 3
5 6 7 8 9 10
4 5 6
D19
2
1
3 4 5 6
7 8 9
2
3
4
5 6 7 8 9 10
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
D20
D21
D22
D23
D24
Black
1 2
1
2
3
4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1
2
3
4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1
1
2
2
389
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
E1
E2
E3
Gray
Gray
Dark Gray
1 2
E4
1
2
3
4
1
4
E6
5
6
5
6
28 29 30 31 32
E5
3
4
7
1
2
3
33 34
E7
4
5
6
1
7
2
3
4
5
6
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31
32 33
34 35
28 29
28 29 30
E8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
9 101112131415
2
3
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
30
31 32
31 32 33 34 35
F1
F2
F5
F6
Brown
Brown
Gray
Gray
1
1
2
1
2
2
3
1
2
3
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
30 31
28 29
F7
F8
Black
Dark Gray
1 2 3
1
F9
2
1
4 5
2
F10
5
6
1
3 4
F11
F14
1 2 3 4 5
4
5
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
G1
3
4
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
21 22 23 24
22 23 24 25 26
G2
G3
H1
Black
Black
Black
1
2
3
17 18 19 20
Black
1
2
1
1
2
3
4
390
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
1
2
K
*3 : w/ Rear Spoiler
*4 : w/o Rear Spoiler
H2
H3
H4
H6
H8
Black
Black
Black
Dark Gray
Dark Gray
1
1
2
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
3
4
3
4
H9
H10
H11
H12
H13
H14
Black
Black
Black
Gray
Black
Gray
1
1
1
1 2 3 4 5
2
1
3 4 5 6
2
H15
H16
H17
H18
H18
Black
Black
Black
(*3) Gray
(*4) Brown
2 1
1
1
1 2
2
3
1 2 3
2
1
2
3
4
3
H19
I1
I2
I3
I4
Black
Black
Black
Black
Black
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
Black
Black
Black
Black
Gray
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
I15
I16
I17
Gray
Gray
Black
1 2
1 2
1
2 3 4 5 6
I18
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
391
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
*5 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
*6 : w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
I19
I20
I20
Black
(*5)
(*6)
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
J1
3
1 2 3
A A A B B B C C C C C
D D D D E E E E E E E
J2
J3
J4
Blue
Blue
Black
J5
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
A A A B B B B C C C C
B B B B B B
B B B B B B
D D D E E E E F F F F
A
J6
A A A B B B C C C C C
A
J7
J8
Blue
Blue
A B B
C C
A A B D D D C C
A A B B C C C D D E E
D D D D E E E E E E E
A
A
A
A
F F F F G G G H H H H
J9
J10
J11
J12
Blue
Black
Black
Black
A A B B C C C D D E E
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
F F F F G G G H H H H
D E F G H I
D E F G H I
D D D E E E
J13
J14
J15
J16
Black
Gray
Gray
Blue
A A B B C C
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
D D D E E E
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
B B B B B B
J17
J18
J19
Blue
Blue
Blue
A A A A A A
A A B B C C C D D E E
A A B B C C C D D E E
B B B B B B
F F F F G G G H H H H
F F F F G G G H H H H
392
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K
J20
J21
J22
J23
Blue
Blue
Black
Black
A A B B C C C D D E E
A A B B C C C D D E E
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
F F F F G G G H H H H
F F F F G G G H H H H
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
J24
J25
J26
J27
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
Blue
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
A
J28
A B B
C C
A A B DD D C C
J29
J30
Blue
Blue
A A A B B B C C C C C
A A B B C C C D D E E
A A B B C C C D D E E
D D D D E E E E E E E
F F F F G G G H H H H
F F F F G G G H H H H
J31
J32
J33
J34
Black
Black
Gray
Gray
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
D E F G H I
D E F G H I
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
J35
J36
Blue
Blue
A A B B C C C D D E E
A A B B C C C D D E E
F F F F G G G H H H H
F F F F G G G H H H H
J37
A
J38
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
A
A
A
A
A
J40
J41
Gray
Gray
A A A B B B B C C C C
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
D D D E E E E F F F F
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
J39
393
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
J42
J43
A B B
C C
A A B D D D C C
A
A
B
B
A
J44
A
A
A
A
C
C
B
B
DE F GHI J K
J46
A
A
B
B
A
A
A
C
C
A
J45
A
A
A
A
C
C
B
B
DE F GHI J K
A
A
A
C
C
DE F GHI J K
J47
J48
J49
J50
J51
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
DE F GHI J K
J52
1
J53
K1
K2
K2
Gray
Black
(1GR–FE) Black
(2UZ–FE) Gray
1 2
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B B
K3
L1
Blue
Black
L2
1
1 2
L3
L4
Black
1
2 1
4 3
1 2
2
3
1 2 3 4 5
2
L5
M1
M1
M2
Black
(1GR–FE) Black
(2UZ–FE) Black
Black
1 2
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
M3
2 1 3
5 4
394
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K
M4
M5
1 2
N2
O1
Gray
Gray
Gray
1 2
1 2
1
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
2 1 3
N1
5 4
O3
O4
O5
O6
Black
Gray
Black
Gray
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
1 2 3
1 2 3
O7
O8
P1
P2
P3
Gray
Black
Gray
Black
Gray
1 2 3
1
1 2 3
1
5 6
P4
P5
P6
2
7
3 4
1
2
8 9
P7
P8
P9
Black
1
1234
1
1 2
P10
P11
1 2 3 4 5
1
2
1 2 3 4 5
P12
P13
P14
Black
Black
Black
1
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
2
1
3 4 5 6
2
3 4 5 6
1
2
3 4 5 6
P15
P16
P17
P18
P19
Black
Yellow
Yellow
Black
Black
1
1
2
3 4 5 6
2
2
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
395
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
P20
P21
P23
P24
Black
Black
Black
Black
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
P27
P28
P25
P26
1 2
1 2
R1
R2
Black
1 2
1 2
3 4
1
R3
R4
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
5 6 7 8 9 10
10
R5
R9
Gray
1
2
3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
R10
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
R11
R12
R13
Blue
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
R14
R15
Gray
Gray
1
2
3 4 5 6
1
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10
1
2
3 4 5 6
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
R16
R17
1
1
2
2
R18
2
3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
R19
R20
R21
R22
R23
Gray
1
1 2 3 4
1
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
4 5
396
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K
R24
R25
R26
R27
Black
Blue
6 7 8 9
1 2 3
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
4 5 6
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
S2
S2
S3
S4
(1GR–FE)
(2UZ–FE)
Black
Black
1
1 2 3 4 5 6
1
S5
1
S6
S11
1 2 3 4 5 6
S12
S13
Blue
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3
9 10111213141516
2
1
4
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
S14
S15
22 23 24 25 26
S16
Yellow
1 2 3 4
1
2
5
6
1
10
3 4
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
17 18 19 20
23 24 25 26
21 22 23 24
27 28 29 30
S17
S18
S19
Yellow
Yellow
Yellow
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
S22
S20
S21
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
S23
S24
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
1
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
2
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
397
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
S25
1
S26
S27
S28
Yellow
Yellow
Black
1 2
1 2
2
3 4 5 6
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
1
2
31
32
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
S29
S30
Black
1 2
1 2 3 4
S31
S32
S33
Gray
Gray
Gray
1 2
1 2
1 2 3 4
3 4
S34
S35
T1
T2
T3
Gray
Gray
Black
Black
Black
1
1 2
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6
T4
T5
1
2
3
4
7
8
9
10 11 12
T6
Black
1
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
3
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
T8
T9
T10
2
4
5
T11
T12
T13
1
2
1 2
1 2
3
4
Gray
12
3
456 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
2
1
3
398
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
5
6
K
T14
T15
T16
T17
Black
1 2
3
4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
3
9 10111213141516
2
4
6
5
7
T18
V1
V1
V2
V2
Blue
(1GR–FE) Brown
(2UZ–FE) Black
(1GR–FE) Gray
(2UZ–FE) Black
1
1 2 3 4 5
2
1
2
1
2
1
V3
V3
V4
V4
V5
(1GR–FE) Black
(2UZ–FE) Dark Gray
(1GR–FE) Black
(2UZ–FE) Dark Gray
Black
1 2 3
1 2
1 2 3
1 2
V6
2
1 2
V7
V9
12
3
456 78
2
1
2
1
V11
V12
V13
Black
Brown
Brown
1
1
1
2
W2
W3
Dark Gray
Black
1
2
3
4
1
2
2
W4
V14
W1
Black
1
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
2
Y1
2
Z1
Black
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4 5
1 2
3 4
399
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
EA1
EA2
Gray
2 1
4 3
1 2
3 4
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
2
5
8
EB1
8
5 6 7 8
ED1
4
7
EB2
3
7
2
6
1
3
4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
IB1
3
2 1
1
2
2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1
8 7 6 5 4
13 12 11 10 9
IB2
1 2
1 2 3
4 5 6
IA1
Dark Gray
IA2
1 2
EC1
Gray
2 1
4 3
1 2
3 4
5
3 2 1
6 5 4
1 2 3
4 5 6
6
1
Gray
4
1 2 3 4
3
Gray
IC1
Yellow
2 1
4 3
2 1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5
1 2
400
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Gray
3 2 1
6 5 4
K
IC2
Gray
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
IC3
Blue
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
IC4
Gray
Gray
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9
10 11
20 21
12 13
22 23
14 15
24 25
16 17
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
19
29
37
18 30 31 32
26 27
38 39 40 28
36
33 34 35
41 42 43
19
9
21 20
11 10
23 22
13 12
25 24
15 14
27 26
37
29
28 40 39 38
43 42 41
17 16
32 31 30 18
36
35 34 33
IC5
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
5 4
3 2 1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6
401
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
ID1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
IE1
Gray
Gray
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
10 11
20 21
12 13
22 23
19
24 25
14 15
16 17
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
19
9
37
29
26 27
36
33 34 35
21 20
11 10
23 22
13 12
25 24
15 14
27 26
38 39 40 28
18 30 31 32
9
28 40 39 38
41 42 43
43 42 41
IF1
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
29
37
32 31 30 18
36
5 4
3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6
II1
IH1
1 2 3
3 2 1
4 5 6
6 5 4
IJ1
3 2 1
4 5 6
6 5 4
35 34 33
IG1
Black
1 2 3
17 16
12
1 2 3 4 5
5 4 3 2 1
6 7 8 9 10
10 9 8 7 6
IK1
2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
402
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K
IL1
IM1
12
2 1
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
IN1
5 4
3 2 1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6
IM2
Blue
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
IN2
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
5 4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6
Yellow
2 1
1 2
IO2
Gray
Gray
9
10 11
20 21
12 13
22 23
14 15
24 25
16 17
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
19
29
37
18 30 31 32
33 34 35
26 27
38 39 40 28
36
41 42 43
19
9
21 20
11 10
23 22
13 12
25 24
15 14
27 26
37
29
28 40 39 38
43 42 41
17 16
32 31 30 18
36
35 34 33
403
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
K CONNECTOR LIST
IO3
IP1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
IP2
1 2
IR1
3
3
4 5 6 7 8
2
2
1
6 5 43
3 4 5 6
8 7 6 5 4
9 10 11 12 13
IU1
Gray
IV1
2 1
Yellow
4
4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
3 2
1
1 2 3 4
BA1
Blue
5 4 3 2 1
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
2
1
7 6 5 4 3
12 11 10 9 8
BB1
BC1
1
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
12
13 12 11 10 9
IT1
1 2 3 4 5
1
2 1
IS1
2
1
5
3 4
6 7 8 9 10 11
2
7 6 5 4 3
12 11 10 9 8
404
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
4 3
2
11 10 9 8 7 6
1
5
K
BC2
BD1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
BD2
1
3
BH1
Gray
2
2
1
4
4
3
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
1
7 6 5 4 3
12 11 10 9 8
BF1
2 1
4 3
1 2
3 4
4 3 2 1
BG1
2
BE1
Green
1 2 3 4
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
1
2
3
3
BI1
Blue
2
1
Gray
3 2 1
6 5 4
1 2 3
4 5 6
5 4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6
Black
BJ1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
BK1
BL1
5
1
2
6
7
3
4
5
8
9
3
2
2
1
1
9
1011121314151617
4
8
7
BM1
2
1
2
1
1
2
6
1716151413121110
405
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
A1
Part Name
Part Number
Code
A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
90980–11070
B4
Body ECU
90980–12562
B5
Body ECU
90980–12560
B6
Body ECU
90980–12561
A/C Lock Sensor
A2
A/C Magnetic Clutch
A9
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A10
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A11
ADD Actuator
A12
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A13
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A14
Airbag Sensor Front LH
A15
Airbag Sensor Front RH
90980–11016
Part Name
Part Number
Back Door Courtesy SW
90980–11003
90980–11858
Back Door Half Latch SW
B7
Back Door Lock Detection SW
90980–11452
Back Door Lock Motor
90980–10869
B8
Back Door ECU
90980–10799
B9
Back Door ECU
90980–11877
90980–11856
A16
A/C Control Assembly
90980–12561
A17
A/C Control Assembly
90980–12560
A18
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A19
A/C Room Temp. Sensor
A20
A/C Solar Sensor
A21
A/C Solar Sensor
A22
A/T Shift Lever Illumination
A24
Accel Position Sensor
90980–11858
A25
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
A26
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
A27
Air Mix Control Servo Motor LH
A28
Air Mix Control Servo Motor RH
Back Door Opener SW
B10
B11
License Plate Light
Back Door Power Window Motor
90980–11178
90980–10797
Buckle SW LH
90980–11918
B12
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
90980–10942
B14
Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
90980–11156
90980–11987
B15
Buckle SW LH
90980–12366
90980–12063
B16
Buckle SW RH
90980–11019
B17
Buckle SW RH
90980–12366
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
90980–11016
C2
Camshaft Timing Oil Control Valve LH
C3
Camshaft Timing Oil Control Valve RH
90980–11909
Crankshaft Position Sensor (1GR–FE)
C4
90980–11162
90980–12028
A29
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
Crankshaft Position Sensor (2UZ–FE)
90980–11162
A30
Airbag Sensor Assembly
82824–50160
C5
Center Speaker
90980–11013
A31
Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11869
C6
Cigarette Lighter
90980–10760
A32
Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11872
C7
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
90980–11148
A33
Airbag Sensor Assembly
82824–50150
C8
Combination Meter
82824–35040
A34
Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11867
C9
Combination Meter
82824–35030
A36
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
90980–12160
C10
Combination Meter
82824–35040
A37
Antenna Amplifier
90980–10870
C11
Combination Meter
82824–35030
A38
Ashtray Illumination
90980–12111
C12
Combination SW
90980–11672
A39
Automatic Light Control Sensor
90980–11107
C13
Combination SW
90980–12552
A40
ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
C14
Combination SW
90980–11594
90980–11299
90980–11900
A41
ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
C15
Cup Holder Illumination
A42
Auto LSD SW
90980–10933
C16
Curtain Shield Airbag Squib LH
A43
Air Injection Control Driver
90980–12068
C17
Curtain Shield Airbag Squib RH
A44
Air Injection Control Driver
90980–11858
D1
Data Link Connector 3
A45
Air Pressure Sensor
90980–10845
A46
Air Pump
90980–11032
A47
Air Switching Valve
90980–11149
A48
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag
Assembly)
90980–12219
A49
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag
Assembly)
90980–12224
B1
Back Door Power Window Control SW
90980–10957
B2
Blower Motor
90980–10385
B3
Blower Motor Controller
90980–11676
90980–12219
90980–11978
Daytime Running Light Relay
D2
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
90980–10803
Defogger SW
Heater Control Panel
D3
Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
90980–11911
Security Indicator Light
D4
Diff. Lock SW
D5
Downhill Assist Control SW
D7
Door Control Receiver
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply.
406
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
90980–11013
90980–11909
L
Code
Part Name
D8
Door Courtesy Light Front LH
D9
Door Courtesy Light Front RH
Part Number
90980–11148
Code
Part Name
Part Number
G3
Glove Box Light
90980–11148
H1
Headlight LH (High)
90980–11095
D10
Door Courtesy Light Rear LH
H2
Headlight LH (Low)
82824–60460
D11
Door Courtesy Light Rear RH
H3
Headlight RH (High)
90980–11095
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
H4
Headlight RH (Low)
82824–60460
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
H9
Horn (High)
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
H10
Horn (Low)
D16
D17
D18
D19
Door Lock Detection SW Front LH
90980–10871
90980–12226
H11
Hazard SW
90980–10789
H12
Height Control SW
90980–10797
Door Lock Control SW Front LH
H13
Height Control Compressor
90980–11156
H14
Height Control Motor
90980–10990
H15
Height Control Sensor Rear LH
Door Lock Detection SW Front RH
H16
Height Control Sensor Rear RH
Door Lock Motor Front RH
H17
Height Control Valve
90980–11143
High Mounted Stop Light (w/ Rear Spoiler)
90980–11272
Power Window Master SW
Door Lock Control SW Front RH
90980–12122
90980–10797
Door Lock Motor Rear LH
90980–12226
Door Lock Detection SW Rear RH
D21
Door Lock Motor Rear RH
Door Speaker Front LH No.1
D23
Door Speaker Front RH No.1
D24
Diode (Rear Wiper)
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
90980–12293
E2
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
90980–10735
E3
Engine Hood Courtesy SW
90980–11178
E4
Engine Control Module
90980–12527
E5
Engine Control Module
90980–12528
E6
Engine Control Module
90980–12526
E7
Engine Control Module
90980–12529
E8
Engine Control Module
90980–12525
F1
Front Fog Light LH
F2
Front Fog Light RH
90980–10935
90980–10962
90980–11096
Front Parking Light LH
90980–11294
Front Turn Signal Light RH
F7
Front Wiper Motor
90980–11599
F8
Fuel Pump Resistor
90980–11156
F9
4WD Control ECU
90980–12560
F10
4WD Control ECU
90980–12561
F11
4WD Control SW
90980–11909
Fuel Pump
F14
Fuel Sender
90980–11077
G1
Generator
90980–09365
G2
Generator
90980–11964
90980–11016
High Mounted Stop Light (w/o Rear Spoiler)
90980–11162
Height Control Mode Select SW
90980–10789
I1
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
I2
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
I3
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.3
I4
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.4
I5
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.5
I6
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.6
I7
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.7
I8
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.8
I9
Injector No.1
I10
Injector No.2
I11
Injector No.3
I12
Injector No.4
I13
Injector No.5
I14
Injector No.6
I15
Injector No.7
I16
Injector No.8
Front Turn Signal Light LH
Front Parking Light RH
F6
H18
H19
D22
F5
90980–10619
Door Lock Motor Front LH
Door Lock Detection SW Rear LH
D20
90980–11028
90980–11885
90980–11875
Ignition Key Cylinder Light
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
90980–12092
I18
Ignition SW
90980–11615
I19
Inner Mirror
90980–11794
Interior Light (w/ Rear Seat Entertainment
System)
90980–12321
Interior Light (w/o Rear Seat Entertainment
System)
–
I20
J1
Junction Connector
J2
Junction Connector
J3
Junction Connector
J4
Junction Connector
90980–11915
90980–11661
90980–11915
407
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
Part Number
Code
J5
Junction Connector
Part Name
90980–10976
J51
Junction Connector
90980–12355
J6
Junction Connector
90980–11915
J52
Junction Connector
90980–10871
J7
Junction Connector
90980–11542
J53
Junction Connector
90980–11542
J8
Junction Connector
K1
Knock Sensor (Bank 1)
J9
Junction Connector
K2
Knock Sensor (Bank 2)
J10
Junction Connector
J11
Junction Connector
J12
Junction Connector
L1
Low Pressure Tank Valve
J13
Junction Connector
L2
Luggage Compartment Light
L3
Lumbar Support Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
90980–10789
L4
Canister Pump Module
90980–12380
L5
Lumbar Support Control Motor (Driver’s
Seat)
90980–10825
Mass Air Flow Meter (1GR–FE)
90980–11317
Mass Air Flow Meter (2UZ–FE)
90980–12292
Main SW
90980–10957
J14
Junction Connector
J15
Junction Connector
J16
Junction Connector
J17
Junction Connector
J18
Junction Connector
J19
Junction Connector
J20
Junction Connector
J21
Junction Connector
J22
Junction Connector
J23
Junction Connector
J24
Junction Connector
J25
Junction Connector
J26
Junction Connector
J27
Junction Connector
J28
Junction Connector
J29
Junction Connector
J30
Junction Connector
J31
Junction Connector
J32
Junction Connector
J33
Junction Connector
J34
Junction Connector
J35
Junction Connector
J36
Junction Connector
J37
Junction Connector
90980–11915
90980–11661
M1
90980–11915
90980–11661
90980–10976
90980–10803
90980–11542
90980–11915
90980–11661
90980–11915
90980–10976
Junction Connector
90980–11915
J40
Junction Connector
J43
Junction Connector
J44
Junction Connector
J45
Junction Connector
J46
Junction Connector
J47
Junction Connector
J48
Junction Connector
J50
Junction Connector
90980–10794
90980–11156
–
Remote Control Mirror RH
N1
Noise Filter (Ignition No.1)
N2
Noise Filter (Ignition No.2)
O1
Oil Pressure SW
90980–11363
O3
Occupant Classification ECU
90980–12356
O4
Occupant Classification ECU
90980–12357
O5
Occupant Classification Sensor Front LH
90980–12353
O6
Occupant Classification Sensor Front RH
O7
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear LH
O8
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear RH
90980–12353
P1
Park/Neutral Position SW
90980–12362
P2
Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
90980–11428
P3
Pressure SW
90980–11149
P4
Parking Brake SW
90980–10871
P5
Power Outlet (115V)
90980–10601
P6
Power Outlet (Front)
90980–10997
90980–10860
90980–10843
90980–12354
Moon Roof Control SW
P7
90980–12355
90980–12189
Moon Roof Control ECU
90980–11542
90980–12374
Remote Control Mirror LH
M5
90980–11661
Junction Connector
J49
Unlock Warning SW
Mirror Heater RH
M4
J39
Junction Connector
90980–11875
Mirror Heater LH
90980–11542
J42
M2
M3
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Part Number
Key Interlock Solenoid
K3
J38
J41
Part Name
Personal Light
P8
Power Outlet (Rear)
P9
Power Window Control SW Front RH
P10
Power Window Control SW Rear LH
P11
Power Window Control SW Rear RH
P12
Power Window Motor Front LH
P13
Power Window Motor Front RH
P14
Power Window Motor Rear LH
P15
Power Window Motor Rear RH
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply.
408
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
90980–10789
90980–10760
90980–10789
90980–10797
L
Code
Part Name
P16
Pretensioner LH
P17
Pretensioner RH
Part Number
S5
90980–12253
Power Seat Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
P19
Power Seat Control SW (Front Passenger’s
Seat)
P20
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Front
Vertical Control)
90980–10997
P21
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Lifter
Control)
P23
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Reclining
Control)
P24
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Slide
Control)
P25
Power Seat Motor (Front Passenger’s Seat
Reclining Control)
P26
Power Seat Motor (Front Passenger’s Seat
Slide Control)
P27
Position Control ECU and SW
90980–10801
P28
Position Control ECU and SW
90980–12551
R1
Radio and Player
90980–12038
R2
Radio and Player
90980–10997
R3
Radio and Player
90980–10996
R4
Radio and Player
90980–12552
R5
Radio and Player
90980–12259
R9
Radio and Player with Display
90980–11909
R10
Radio and Player with Display
90980–12259
90980–10825
R11
Radio and Player with Display
90980–12552
R12
Radio and Player with Display
90980–12038
R13
Rheostat
R14
Rear Combination Light LH
R15
Rear Combination Light RH
R16
Rear Door Speaker LH
R17
Rear Door Speaker RH
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
R19
Rear Speaker LH
R20
Rear Speaker RH
R21
Rear Window Defogger
R22
Rear Window Defogger
90980–10797
90980–10935
90980–12556
90980–11013
90980–10359
Rear Wiper Motor
90980–11599
Rear Wiper Position SW
R24
Remote Control Mirror SW
90980–11657
R25
Roll Sensing of Curtain Shield Airbag Cutoff
SW
90980–11013
R26
Radio and Player with Display
90980–12404
R27
Radio and Player with Display
90980–12209
Starter (1GR–FE)
90980–09463
Starter (2UZ–FE)
90980–09585
S2
S3
Starter
90980–11400
S4
Seat Heater SW LH
90980–10957
Part Name
Seat Heater SW RH
Part Number
90980–10933
Shift Lock Control ECU
S6
P18
R23
Code
Transmission Control SW
90980–12552
S11
Steering Sensor
90980–12553
S12
Stop Light SW
90980–11118
S13
Suspension Control ECU
90980–12561
S14
Suspension Control ECU
90980–12560
S15
Suspension Control ECU
90980–12562
S16
Side Airbag Sensor Front LH
S17
Side Airbag Sensor Front RH
S18
Side Airbag Sensor Rear LH
S19
Side Airbag Sensor Rear RH
S20
Door Speaker Front LH No.2
S21
Door Speaker Front RH No.2
S22
Stereo Component Amplifier
90980–12554
S23
Stereo Component Amplifier
90980–10821
S24
Seat Heater LH
S25
Seat Heater RH
S26
Side Airbag Squib LH
S27
Side Airbag Squib RH
S28
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
90980–12297
S29
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
90980–12294
S30
Seat Memory SW
90980–11090
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
82824–21030
S32
Step Light Front LH
S33
Step Light Front RH
S34
Step Light Rear LH
S35
Step Light Rear RH
T1
Theft Deterrent Horn
90980–12225
90980–11013
90980–10797
90980–11864
90980–11162
90980–10619
Throttle Control Motor
T2
Throttle Position Sensor
90980–11858
T3
Transfer Shift Actuator
90980–11664
T4
Turbine Speed Sensor
90980–11156
T5
Theft Deterrent ECU
90980–12557
T6
Towing Brake Controller
90980–11603
T8
Transponder Key Computer
90980–11911
T9
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
90980–10799
T10
Tailgate Control SW
90980–11015
90980–11292
T11
Television Camera
T12
Tension Reducer Solenoid LH
T13
Tension Reducer Solenoid RH
T14
Towing Converter Relay
90980–11535
T15
Trailer Socket
82824–34030
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
90980–12553
T17
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and
Receiver
90980–11909
90980–12063
409
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
T18
V1
V2
V3
V4
Part Name
Part Number
Telephone Microphone
90980–12366
VSV (ACIS) (1GR–FE)
90980–11149
VSV (ACIS) (2UZ–FE)
90980–11156
VSV (Purge)
90980–11156
VVT Sensor (Bank 1) (2UZ–FE)
90980–10947
VVT Sensor (Bank 2) (1GR–FE)
90980–12353
VVT Sensor (Bank 1) (1GR–FE)
90980–12353
VVT Sensor (Bank 2) (2UZ–FE)
90980–10947
V5
VSC Warning Buzzer
V6
Vanity Light LH
V7
Vanity Light RH
V9
Voltage Inverter
90980–10906
90980–12322
Code
Part Name
Part Number
V11
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Electronically
Controlled Transmission)
V12
VSV (Air Switching Valve Bank 1)
V13
VSV (Air Switching Valve Bank 2)
V14
Video Terminal
90980–12551
W1
Washer Level Sensor
90980–11068
W2
Washer Motor
90980–11028
W3
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
90980–11142
W4
Woofer
90980–10795
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
90980–11904
Z1
Option Connector (TVIP ECU)
90980–10795
90980–10799
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply.
410
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
90980–11156
90980–11149
Memo
411
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1 4RUNNER
P o w e r S o u rc e
∗ 1 : 1GR–FE Cold Area Spec.
∗ 2 : 1GR–FE Except Cold Area Spec.
S ta rtin g
1
4
3
2
ACC
IG1
AM1
7 AM2
IG2
ST2 8
G–B
J27(B), J28(A)
Junction
Connector
R
I18
Ignition SW
B–Y
A A
A A
A A (2UZ–FE)
B B
B B
B B (1GR–FE)
7. 5A
STA
NO. 2
B–Y
2
R
2
2 1K
5
1
2 IC4
G
6 IM2 (2UZ–FE)
4 IM2 (1GR–FE)
G
2
J35
G
Junction
Connector
5
2
P
L–Y
W–B
S 2(A), (B), S 3(C)
Starter
Engine Control
Module
< 5–12> < 5–14> < 6–14>
1 C
P
B
Combination Meter
< 31–3>
J3
Junction Connector
B
Y–G(2UZ–FE)
Y (1GR–FE)
(2UZ–FE)
(1GR–FE)
B
1 1
A B
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
N
4
6 EA1 (2UZ–FE)
4 EA2 (1GR–FE)
1
B–R(2UZ–FE)
B–L(∗1)
W (∗2)
B–Y
W–B
2
2
L–Y
2
2
30A
AM2
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
3
11 IM1
B–Y
STA Relay
Y–G
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
R
3 1D
Battery
EB
M
415
Front Left
Fender
B–Y
P o w e r S o u rc e
R
W–B
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
B–R
B–R
I8
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 8
I7
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 7
I6
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
I5
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
I4
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
I3
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
I2
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
I1
Ignition Coil
and Igniter No. 1
N1
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 1)
N2
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 2)
R–W
G–B
R–Y
G–W
R–Y
G
R–W
B–L
R–Y
L–Y
R–W
L–W
R–W
LG–B
R–Y
LG
W–B
W–B
B
Battery
R–W
R–Y
W–B
Engine Control Module
< 5–13> < 5–14>
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
Rear Side of
Front Right
Fender
ER
EC
Right Bank
Cylinder Head
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
R–W
R–W
R–W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
R–Y
R–Y
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
2
B–R
4
3
B–R
1
1
B–R
4
4
4
1
B–R
1
1
1
4
2
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
1
4
1
B–R
B–R
4
3
2
1
1
4
2
B–R
B–R
2
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
1
4
2
1
30A
AM2
B–R
IG2 6
7 AM2
Ig n itio n (2 U Z – F E )
ST2
I18
Ignition SW
7 EA1
1 EB1
B
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
416
2 4RUNNER
3 4RUNNER
B–R
13 IM1
B–R
R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
B–R
B–R
I6
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
I5
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
I4
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
I3
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
I2
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
I1
Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
W–R
L
W–R
GR
W–R
LG–B
W–R
LG
W–R
P–L
W–R
Y–R
W–B
W–B
W–R
M
417
Rear Side of
Left Bank
Cylinder Block
EF
2
2
2
2
2
N1
Noise Filter
(Ignition No. 1)
B
Battery
3
3
3
3
3
2
2
1
3
1
W–R
W–R
4
4
4
4
4
W–R
W–R
1
1
1
1
1
4
2
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
4
3
2
1
B–R
B–R
B–R
2
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
1
30A
AM2
B–R
IG2 6
7 AM2
Ig n itio n (1 G R – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
ST2
I18
Ignition SW
6 1D
4 1H
Engine Control Module
< 6–13> < 6–14>
P o w e r S o u rc e
C h a rg in g
1
∗ 1 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 2 : 1GR–FE
4
3
2
ACC
W–L
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
R
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
2 1C
ST2
15A IG1
Body ECU
< 7–39>
6 1D
GR
W–L
W
E B
20 1E
Y–R
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
2
4 1G
E
2
A A
R–L
Junction
Connector
E
2
2
2
Junction
Connector
D
Y–R
2 EA1 (∗1)
2 EA2 (∗2)
GR
1 EA1 (∗1)
3 EA2 (∗2)
1 EA2
2
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination
Meter
16 A
1
5 EA1
2
Charge
GR
1
W
7. 5A ALT–S
30A AM2
140A ALT
1
J1
2
6 IC4
W
GR
GR
Y–R
W
R
D
15 C
2
1
J1
A A
2
50A AM1
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
7. 5A GAUGE
I18
Ignition SW
2
Y–R
G B
B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
GR
W
B
G A
GR
1 B
S
L B
IG B
B A
Battery
4
Y–R
2
W
1
G 1(A), G 2(B)
Generator
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
418
4 4RUNNER
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
419
E n g in e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
W–R
A
GR
B
R
C
B–R
D
B–O
E
B
F
R–L
B–R
B–O
IG1
8 EA1
B–O
1
2
2
3
2
2
2
2
B–W
B
B
8 1K
J4
Junction
Connector
38 IC4
A
2
2
W–B
Battery
1
2
17
IC3
4 IM1
ACC CUT
Relay
4
L–W
3
A
L–W
P
B
2
GR–B
A
L
2
P
Remote Control Mirror System
< 24–3>
Navigation System
< 28–2>
Audio System
< 28–2> < 29–2> < 30–2>
Parking Assist
(Rear View Monitor) System< 28–2>
Air Conditioning System
< 32–3>
B
B B
33 IC4
L–W
F 3E
11 IC4
W
1
B A
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
B
9 IC4
F 3E
30A
AM2
1
L–W
2
W
W–B
W–B
2
P
1
5
2
R–L
1
2
20A EFI
10A ETCS
Short Pin
1
B
2
B
2
15A A/F HEATER
2
2
2
2
C/OPN Relay
7. 5A
ACC
B
L
L
B–R
GR
W
2
3
2
2
4 1G
2
B
10A
IGN
1
2
2
1
K
2
7. 5A
GAUGE
R
2
2
5
2
10A EFI NO. 2
140A ALT
3
1
2
2
J
B–W
B
2
1
1
B
5 1D
B–R
23 1E
B
11 1J
2
EFI Relay
6 1D
2
A/F HEATER Relay
B–O
B–O
W–G
2
5
I18
Ignition
SW
W–G
C
I
W–G
B
L
B–R
ST2
1
1
IG2 6
B–R
10A ECU–B
1
50A AM1
2
7. 5A OBD
50A A/PUMP
2
7 AM2
H
L
W–G
L
B–R
W–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
2
35
IC4
12 IC4
C
2
J4
Junction
Connector
2
2
B
O
R
L
W–L
2
O
ACC 3 W–G
2 AM1
G
W–G
W–G
GR–B
B
1
IB2
L–W
12
IM1
L–W
16
IC3
L–W
W–G
Front Left
Fender
EB
N
O
P
W–G
W
2
L
M
Q
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
420
(Cont. next page)
5 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
5 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
E n g in e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
A
B
E
R–L
Y
V
B
G
B–R
B–O
L
O
W–G
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
< 26–3>
L
14 IC3
Multiplex Communication
System (CAN)< 15–11>
10 IC3
32 IC4
G
Y
C 3C
V
P–L
C 3C
5
4
15
SIL
TS
12
7
23 E
4 E
AIDI
25 E
AIRV
AIRP
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
ACCR
FPR
FC
30 C
17 E
10 E
GR–B
W–G
G–R
F A
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
F A
13 E
TC
R–Y
R–Y
R–Y
R–B
Body ECU
< 7–38>
F A
Airbag Sensor
Assembly< 20–6>
R–B
R–Y
D
R–Y
R–Y
G B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
B
Skid Control
ECU with
Actuator< 15–4>
Suspension
Control
ECU< 18–3>
Skid Control
ECU with
Actuator< 15–4>
Suspension
Control
ECU< 18–3>
A 3A
R–Y
R–Y
R–Y
BR
W–B
W–B
G–R
9 IM2
B R–Y
D
D
G A
R–Y
E
E
G A
B
J1
Junction
Connector
A A
E B
A A
G A
A 3A
A 3A
15 IC2
R–B
A A
J4
Junction
Connector
J22
Junction
Connector
W–B
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
M
1
C 3C
Occupant
Classification
ECU< 20–10>
WFSE
BR
A46
Air Pump
A47
Air Switching Valve
W–B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
2
2
P–L
CG
Skid Control
ECU with
Actuator< 15–4>
L
F14
Fuel Pump
1
P–L
SG
4 IN1
G
B–R
G–R
F8
Fuel Pump
Resistor
M
5
P–L
E
1 B
4 IC2
4
H B
R–Y
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
< 26–3>
W–G
GR–B
B
B
L–W
L–W
L–W
L–W
W
BR
W–B
W–B
W–B
Q
BL
BO
EQ
Near the
Starter
Left Bank
Cylinder
Head
ED
K
L
J5
Junction
Connector
IG
Left Kick
Panel
M
421
Rear
Pillar
LH
I
J
A
W
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
H
D1
Data Link Connector 3
B–R
W–B
TC
CANL
R–B
3 EA1
13
14
CANH
R–W
G
4 EA1
6
BAT
DI
BR
L
B–R
B–Y
G–R
2
IB1
B–R
16
2 B
SIV
H A
A B
E A
P–L
3 B
SIP
W–B
2
19 IM2
P
4 B
BR
2
1
O
P–L
BATT
A43(A), A44(B)
Air Injection Control Driver
VV
VP
6 B
2 A
2
5 IC4
H A
O
1 A
+B
5
2
H A
V
5 B
4
1
M
Y
3
FUEL
PUMP
Relay
L
G
R
2
2
B
2
R–Y
A B
J18(A)
Junction Connector
F
G
P–L
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
< 20–6>
4 IC3
P–L
D
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
B–W
O
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Suspension
Control
ECU< 18–3>
W–G
C
E
R–L
B–W
N
A
B
B–R
I
K
GR
B–O
H
J
W–R
R
F
G
8
7
6
GR
C
D
5
W–R
E n g in e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
A
B
9
W–R
12
11
10
W–R
R–Y
C
D
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
I16
Injector No. 8
I15
Injector No. 7
I14
Injector No. 6
I13
Injector No. 5
I12
Injector No. 4
I11
Injector No. 3
Park/Neutral
Position SW
< 1–2>
2
BR
W
R
G
Y
W
P
# 60
VTA1
AIP
3 A
7 C
# 50
20 A
32 A
2 A
# 70
VTA2
19 A
8 B
# 80
M+
M–
5 A
STAR/NSW
GE01
4 A
17 A
ACIS
THW
21 A
PRG
34 A
33 A
W–L
Y–R
R
1 B
1 B
V 2(B)
VSV (Purge)
2 B
V 1(B)
VSV (ACIS)
1
2 B
L–W
L–W
BR
W
BR
R
4 EB2
E2
3
5
BR
3 EB2
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
VC
2
E2
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
M–
R–L
1
M+
(Shielded)
2
G
4
VTA2
R
E2
1
L–R
7 IM2
R–B
VC
3
L–R
L–R
22 IM2
Y
AIP
A45
Air Pressure Sensor
2
L–R
3
6
VTA1
1 EB2
W–L
42 IE1
L–R
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
1
L–R
16 IM2
L–W
L–R
BR
W–B
W
1
2
2
6 C
# 40
VC
B
L–W
1
1
2
5 C
# 30
23 A
W
43 IE1
BR
W–B
O
L
9 IE1
4
BR
28 IE1
2
L–R
6
W–B
1
O
11 IE1
9
L–W
K
B
Vent Valve
C A
R–G
8
R
J
Leak
Detection Pump
R
R–G
M
2
3
1
2
4 C
# 20
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
G2+
G2–
19 C
29 C
Canister
Pressure Sensor
17 IE1
I
# 10
L4
Canister Pump Module
A B
B–R
22 E
L
5 E
I10
Injector No. 2
6 E
2
3 C
2 C
IGSW
MPMP VPMP PPMP
O
B
B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
2 E
A
9 E
W
J26
Junction
Connector
+B2
30 D
+BM
1
C
B–R
R–L
+B
7 E
B–R
A
A
B–O
BATT
R–B
3 E
MREL
1 E
GR
L
W–G
8 E
B–R
1
2
R–L
7 A
R–L
B B
2
B–R
B–R
B A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
B A
1
1
B–O
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
GR
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
13 IC4
B
I9
Injector No. 1
R–Y
B–R
B–R
Combination
Meter< 31–3>
B
15 C
B–O
H
L
W–G
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
G
B–O
J8
Junction
Connector
R–L
B
B–R
B–O
B–O
F
4
EB1
B–R
R–L
E
A
GR
BR
BR
BR
W
BR
L–W
C
L–W
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
C
D
J28
Junction Connector
D
C
D
E
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
422
(Cont. next page)
5 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
5 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
E n g in e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
A
B
C
13
W–R
16
15
14
W–R
R–Y
R–Y
B–O
B–O
DEFOG
Fuse< 7–36>
VPA2
VCP1
VCP2
EP1
EP2
6
3
4
1
5
2
VG
30 A
9 A
IGT7
E2G
29 A
24 A
IGT8
THA
E2
22 A
25 A
IGF1
28 A
12 C
IGF2
STSW
11 C
17 C
STA
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
HA2A
A2A+
A2A–
1 B
23 B
31 B
A1A+
22 B
15 C
16 C
OC1+
A1A–
30 B
14 C
OC2+
OC1–
HA1A
2 B
12 D
OC2–
HT2B
OX1B
33 B
18 A
NE–
NE+
21 C
L
Y
(Shielded)
+B
2
HT
1
HT
OX
+B
E1
2
4
3
1
OX
HT
+B
2
E1
4
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
2 B
1 B
C 4(B)
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
AF–
3
J28
Junction
Connector
AF+
1
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
4
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
BR
L–W
BR
L–W
R–L
BR
EPA2
W–B
3
W
C
BR
21 E
EPA
20 C
C
C
W–B
C
W–B
W
BR
+B
2
W
D
HT
J26
Junction
B–W Connector
BR
W
AF–
1
BR
L–W
E
AF+
20 E
VCP2
G–Y
E2
5 B
4
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
+B
1 B
L–W
D
THA
3
A12
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
E2G
4 B
A13
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
VG
2 B
M 1(B)
Mass Air Flow Meter
V13
VSV
(Air Switching Valve Bank 2)
L–W
1
L–W
V12
VSV
(Air Switching Valve Bank 1)
1
3 B
27 E
VCPA
HT1B
B
(Shielded)
W
P
(Shielded)
R–L
BR
Y
(Shielded)
L
P
B–W
(Shielded)
BR
Y–B
B–W
W–R
P
L
2
26 E
VPA2
1 A
W–B
2
19 E
VPA
ELS1
OX2B
5 B
18 E
13 D
ELS2
V–W
14 A
IGT6
V–W
12 A
IGT5
C
8 IC3
LG–B
AIV1
27 A
13 A
LG–B
AIV2
26 A
IGT4
29 IC4
W–L
10 A
IGT3
W–L
11 A
IGT2
9 IC3
B–Y
15 A
26 IC4
R–B
IGT1
31 IC4
W–R
Y–G
8 A
B–Y
34 IC4
R–B
TAIL Fuse
< 10–5>
G
Y–R
P
LG
R–W
D B
VPA1
W–R
I A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
1
B
A24
Accel Position Sensor
Y–G
C3
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve RH
C2
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve LH
1
B–Y
L–Y
R–W
R–Y
G–B
G–W
G
B–L
L–Y
L–W
LG–B
LG
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
STA Relay
< 1–3>
STA NO. 2 Fuse
< 1–3>
Ignition Coil and Igniters
< 2–1> < 2–2> < 2–3> < 2–4>
2
2
A
J28
Junction Connector
D
E
D
C
ED
M
423
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
E n g in e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
A
17
W–R
E n g in e Im m o b ilis e r S y s te m (2 U Z – F E )
20
19
18
W–R
B
R–Y
4 1B
C
B–O
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
4 1L
4WD Control ECU
< 19–2>
W–R
Multiplex
Communication
System (CAN)
< 15–11> < 15–12>
A/C Control
Assembly
< 32–12>
W–L
(4WD)
B–W
Stop Light SW
< 11–1>
ANT1
ANT2
B 3E
VC5
CODE
1
4
TXCT
GND
5
7
B 3E
E01
7 A
E02
6 A
4WD
8 C
E04
7 B
E05
6 B
E03
4 B
ME01
3 B
IMI
16 D
KSW
10
12
13
CODE
TXCT
AGND
CTY
IND
4
3
T8
V–W
R–B
5
LP
W–B
A A
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
< 7–31>
A A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
R
(Shielded)
G
A A
7
Unlock Warning SW
< 7–19>
7 EB1
Transponder Key
Computer
D3
Security Indicator
Light
G–Y
6 EB1
B 3F
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B 3F
B 3F
2
Rear Side of
Cylinder Block
EE
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
ED
A
A
A
IK
J24
Junction
Connector
J37
Junction
Connector
1
W–B
W–B
K1
Knock Sensor
(Bank 1)
K 2(B)
Knock Sensor
(Bank 2)
1 B
GND
14
W–B
3 EB1
B
W
W–B
7
11
VC5
L–R
A B
W–B
EFII
6
W–B
8 EB1
EFIO
8
GND
1 IM2
BR
2 B
2 EB1
(Shielded)
E
IMO
15 D
+B
W–R
BR
1 B
2 B
D
EOM
35 D
W–B
V 4(B)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
V 3(B)
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
2 B
W–B
BR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
(4WD)
W–B
W–B
R
(Shielded)
G
B
W
(Shielded)
G
R
(Shielded)
L
Y
1 B
EC
9 C
1
D
L
E1
1 C
9
IG
ACT
LG–R
EKNK
28 B
2
25 D
P–G
KNK1
29 B
AC1
GR–B
EKN2
20 B
24 D
THWO
W–R
VV1–
14 D
CANL
R–Y
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
VV2+
VV2–
KNK2
18 C
28 C
21 B
24 C
34 D
CANH
STP
B–O
33 D
15 E
L4
BR–W
13 C
F/PS
GR–G
VV1+
32 D
L–B
TACH
G–Y
1 D
W–L
(4WD)
F B
SPD
25 C
5 IM2
L
V–R
8 D
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B–W
G A
(Shielded)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly< 20–6>
Combination
Meter< 31–4>
< 31–6>
Transponder Key Coil
W–B
Right Kick
Panel
Instrument Panel
Brace RH
II
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
424
5 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
425
E n g in e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
W–R
A
GR
B
B–R
C
B–O
ACC 3
O
2 AM1
W–L
W–G
R–L
IG1
7 AM2
W–G
I
B
B–O
B
B
B
B
B–R
B
5 1D
W–G
23 1E
12 IC4
L
11 1J
W–G
3 1H
H
B–W
2
2
1
7. 5A
ACC
1
L
L
B–R
GR
W
2
3
2
2
1
3
2
2
2
2
B–W
B
2
B
1
F 3E
1
P
11 IC4
4
IM1
W–G
Battery
4
17
IC3
1
2
B
W–B
ACC
CUT
Relay
2
W–G
EB
Front Left
Fender
W–G
GR–B
B
L–W
W
L–W
A
L–W
9 IC4
2
A
W
3
2
33 IC4
A
L–W
B
B B
2
B A
J4
Junction
Connector
L
P
Remote Control Mirror System
< 24–3>
Navigation System
< 28–2>
Audio System
< 28–2> < 29–2> < 30–2>
Parking Assist
(Rear View Monitor) System< 28–2>
Air Conditioning System
< 32–4>
38 IC4
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
2
GR–B
F 3E
30A
AM2
L–W
20A
EFI
W
1
2
W–B
1
2
2
W–B
10A ETCS
Short Pin
1
2
2
5
B
2
15A A/F HEATER
2
2
2
P
2
R–L
2
3
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
8 1K
B
B
4 1G
2
5
C/OPN Relay
10A
IGN
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
1
10A EFI NO. 2
2
2
1
EFI Relay
R
5
A/F HEATER Relay
140A
ALT
2
W–G
G
C
B–O
B–O
10A ECU–B
6 1D
B–R
1
1
B–R
I18
Ignition SW
35
IC4
W–G
L
ST2
F
L
C
IG2 6
J4
Junction
Connector
50A AM1
7. 5A OBD
W–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
2
2
B–O
2
2
E
O
L
2
D
1
IB2
16
IC3
L–W
12
IM1
J
K
L
M
N
O
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
426
(Cont. next page)
6 4RUNNER
6 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
E n g in e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
A
B
C
D
5
W–R
8
7
6
W–R
A
GR
B–R
B–R
B–O
B–O
B
C
R–L
E
O
F
2
GR
7 E
BATT
ACCR
17 E
+BM
FC
10 E
PSW
10 C
G–W
GR–B
W–G
F A
H B
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
< 26–3>
1
P2
Power Steering Oil
Pressure SW
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
R–Y
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–4>
FPR
30 C
Y–B
F A
3 E
MREL
R–Y
R–Y
F A
8 E
TC
A 3A
R–Y
R–Y
Body ECU
< 7–38>
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
< 20–6>
W–B
A A
W–G
GR–B
B
L–W
W
L–W
R–Y
J22
Junction
Connector
J1
Junction
Connector
R–Y
B
G B
A 3A
23 E
L
G A
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
G A
R–Y
R–Y
R–Y
G A
B
J4
Junction
Connector
R–B
E
C 3C
A 3A
R–Y
R–B
R–W
D
A B
BR
O
E
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–B
N
15 IC2
D
9 IM2
W–B
Y–B
K
4 IC2
F14
Fuel Pump
5
19 IM2
M
7
R–Y
B–R
M
F8
Fuel Pump
Resistor
W–B
A B
L
12
4
1
J
15
C 3C
SIL
R–B
BR
B–R
2
5 IC4
4
W–B
B–R
B–Y
2
IB1
B–R
5
C 3C
W–G
2
TC
D1
Data Link Connector 3
WFSE
TS
P–L
2
CG
13
CANL
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C),
E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
2
SG
14
Occupant Classification
ECU< 20–10>
5
6
CANH
13 IC4
P–L
9
E A
P–L
4
P–L
TAC
16
FUEL
PUMP
Relay
P–L
B–W
BAT
3
1
H A
2
O
2
H A
A B
B
L–W
W
L–W
Rear
Pillar
LH
BO
BR
BL
W–B
W–B
F
G
H
I
A
J5
Junction Connector
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder
Block
EE
IG
Left Kick
Panel
M
427
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
E
GR
32 IC4
A B
P–L
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
Combination
Meter< 31–4>
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
< 20–6>
B–W
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
Multiplex Communication
System (CAN)< 15–11>
O
B–W
R–Y
P–L
W–G
Y–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
I
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
< 26–3>
L
G
H
D
R–L
E n g in e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
A
9
W–R
12
11
10
W–R
R–Y
5
IM1
B
C
B–R
B–O
B–R
B–R
C2
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve LH
1
I A
D B
G
L–R
L–W
L–B
G–Y
L
Y
Y–G
3 C
# 10
TAIL Fuse
< 10–5>
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
C3
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve RH
1
1
Y–G
2
I14
Injector No. 6
1
G
R
B
2 C
IGSW
5 E
I13
Injector No. 5
1
2
2
I12
Injector No. 4
I11
Injector No. 3
I10
Injector No. 2
1
4 C
# 20
5 C
# 30
VC
22 E
6 C
# 40
MPMP VPMP PPMP
6 E
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
34 A
2
R–L
PRG
ACIS
33 A
J27
Junction
Connector
+B2
2 E
1
R–L
+B
1 E
D
9 E
W
2
C
DEFOG
Fuse< 7–36>
D
D
B–O
R–B
30 D
B–R
2
I9
Injector No. 1
7 A
1
R–L
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
B A
B–R
2
B–O
B A
B B
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
2
B
B–O
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
R–Y
B–R
B–R
Combination
Meter
< 31–3>
B
15 C
E
B–O
J8
Junction
Connector
R–L
B
B–R
B–O
R–L
D
A
23 A
7 C
# 50
VTA1
20 A
17 C
# 60
VTA2
19 A
M+
5 A
M–
4 A
15 C
16 C
OC1+
OC2+
OC1–
GE01
17 A
THW
30 A
12 D
ELS1
OC2–
VG
21 A
13 D
14 C
E2G
29 A
ELS2
THA
E2
22 A
28 A
L4
Canister Pump Module
Rear Side of
Left Bank
Cylinder Block
THA
+B
E2
1 A
5 A
BR
EF
4 A
BR
BR
W–B
L–W
L–W
L–W
E2G
L–W
BR
W
7 IM2
L–R
BR
L–W
1
2 A
M 1(A)
Mass Air Flow Meter
E2
3
R
L–R
22 IM2
5
42 IE1
L–R
17 IM2
43 IE1
VG
R–B
9 IE1
3 A
R–W
28 IE1
R–Y
11 IE1
L
VC
17 IE1
2
E2
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
M–
B–L
1
M+
T2
Throttle Control Motor
Throttle Position Sensor
2
(Shielded)
G–W
4
VTA2
P
G–B
6
VTA1
L–R
4
BR
1 A
2
BR
I
1 A
6
W–B
H
B
L–W
W
L–W
1
O
R
G
2 A
V 2(A)
VSV (Purge)
F
V 1(A)
VSV (ACIS)
2 A
9
W–B
8
L–W
3
R–G
C A
M
Leak
Detection Pump
Vent Valve
G–Y
W–L
A B
L–R
R
R–G
O
B
B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
Canister
Pressure Sensor
BR
BR
BR
L–W
W
L–R
D
E
F
G
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
428
(Cont. next page)
6 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
6 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
E n g in e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
A
B
C
13
W–R
16
15
14
W–R
R–Y
R–Y
B–O
B–O
A
B
C
A24
Accel Position Sensor
2
8 IC3
V–W
21 E
EPA
EPA2
NE–
VV2–
20 C
28 C
NE+
21 C
1 A
C 4(A)
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
2 A
B
W
(Shielded)
2 A
V–W
20 E
VCP2
V 3(A)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
3 A
27 E
L
1 A
29 IC4
LG–B
VV2+
18 C
VCPA
LG–B
26 E
VPA2
9 IC3
W–L
B–Y
19 E
Y
2 A
R–B
VV1–
29 C
26 IC4
W–L
31 IC4
B–Y
R–B
J28
Junction
Connector
3 A
VPA
V 4(A)
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
E
E
EP2
5
G
R
E
EP1
1
W–R
BR–W
GR–G
L–B
E1
4
1 A
E
VCP2
4
18 E
ACT
VV1+
E
VCP1
3
34 IC4
25 D
19 C
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HT
VPA2
6
W–R
A/C Control
Assembly
< 32–12>
Multiplex
Communication
System (CAN)
< 15–11> < 15–12>
AC1
G
1
OX
+B
24 D
THWO
HT1B
3
2
14 D
CANL
1 A
W
E1
4
OX1B
18 A
34 D
CANH
STA
(Shielded)
+B
B–Y
OX
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
3
HT
2
STA Relay
< 1–3>
P
B
L
(Shielded)
HT
1
1
33 D
11 C
STAR/NSW
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
HT2B
OX2B
5 B
33 B
R–L
+B
HA1A
A12
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
AF–
8 B
STSW
2 B
L
4
12 C
IGF1
A1A–
AF+
2
24 A
30 B
3
L–Y
IGT6
W–R
13 A
P
+B
2
BR
BR
L–W
BR
L–W
R–L
W
W
A
BR
L–R
A
L–R
G
(Shielded)
AF–
A13
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
4
AF+
J27
Junction
B–W Connector
F
BR
L–W
W
L–R
A1A+
22 B
BR
Y
B–W
(Shielded)
3
HT
E
IGT5
A2A–
31 B
1
D
12 A
IGT4
L
A2A+
23 B
11 A
IGT3
GR
10 A
IGT2
HA2A
LG–B
9 A
IGT1
1 B
LG
P–L
Y–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
8 A
Park/Neutral
Position SW< 1–2>
STA NO. 2 Fuse< 1–3>
Ignition Coil and Igniters
< 3–2> < 3–3> < 3–4>
VPA1
A
BR
BR
D
L–R
EE
M
429
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
E n g in e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
E n g in e Im m o b ilis e r S y s te m (1 G R – F E )
17
W–R
A
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
430
6 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
20
19
18
W–R
R–Y
B
4 1B
B–O
C
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
4 1L
4WD Control ECU
< 19–2>
Stop Light SW
< 11–1>
VC5
1
E02
6 A
E04
7 B
E05
6 B
E03
4 B
ME01
3 B
EOM
IMO
35 D
15 D
IMI
16 D
EFII
6
7
8
11
12
13
VC5
CODE
TXCT
AGND
T8
Transponder Key Computer
GND
KSW
14
10
CTY
IND
4
3
V–W
R–B
G–Y
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
BR
BR
BR
W–B
W
(Shielded)
5
LP
D3
Security Indicator Light
W
B
(Shielded)
A A
A A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
W–B
EE
Rear Side of
Left Bank
Cylinder Block
EF
A
A
A
IK
W–B
J37
Junction
Connector
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
B 3F
W–B
K1
Knock Sensor
(Bank 1)
2
B 3F
B 3F
W–B
1
7
W–B
5 ED1
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
< 7–31>
2 ED1
Unlock Warning SW
< 7–19>
1 ED1
BR
2 A
EFIO
+B
GND
BR
BR
7
L
E01
7 A
1
D
L–R
K 2(A)
Knock Sensor
(Bank 2)
D
GND
5
LG–R
E1
1 C
9
IG
W–R
R
G
(Shielded)
1 A
TXCT
P–G
EKNK
28 B
B
R
G
(Shielded)
6 ED1
4
GR–B
2
STP
W–R
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
15 E
L4
R–Y
29 B
B–O
13 C
4WD
KNK1
20 B
G–Y
EKN2
8 C
BR
4 ED1
CODE
B 3E
W–L
(4WD)
KNK2
F/PS
GR
(4WD)
L
32 D
TACH
21 B
ANT2
ANT1
B 3E
15 IM2
B–W
SPD
W–L
(4WD)
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
1 D
8 D
ADD Actuator
< 19–3>
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
< 20–6>
B–W
V–R
F B
W–R
Combination
Meter< 31–4>
< 31–6>
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
G A
Transponder Key Coil
J24
W–B
Right Kick
Panel
Junction
Connector
II
Instrument Panel
Brace RH
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
431
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
W–L
ACC 3
W–G
IG1 4
L–Y
2 AM1
ACC
22
BDR1
BECU
12
11
9 1E
4 1B
CLTB
6 C
CLTE
CLTS
21 C
4 C
B–R
I18
Ignition SW
5 1D
12 1F
3 IG1
2 IG1
1 IG1
L–Y
G–W
Y
3
4
CLTE
CLTS
W–R
W–R
W–R
G–W
W–G
R–L
1
CLTB
Y–R
A39
Automatic Light
Control Sensor
E
E
2
2
2
2
W
R–B
2
1
W
R–B
G–W
1
B–Y
(∗1)
2
10A DOME
2
1
2
10A ECU–B
W
R
1
2
2
50A J/B
5
1
2
15A FR FOG
4
2
2
R
W–R
2
2
3
L–W
2
50A AM1
DEFOG Relay
1
2
LG
2
W–L
2
W–B
B–R
R
Y–R
J1
Junction Connector
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
4 1G
4 1L
Y
R
7. 5A GAUGE
ST2
G–W
7. 5A
ACC
6 1D
IG2 6
L–Y
7 AM2
2
2
2
LG
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
2
W–R
5
W–R
L–W
L–Y
Y–R
R–L
R
R
B–R
B–Y(∗1)
R–B
R–B
W
W
W–B
1
2
B
B
1
3
HEAD Relay
1
20A DR/LCK
1
Short Pin
30A AM2
140A
ALT
A
2
15A TRN–HAZ
2
Battery
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
432
(Cont. next page)
7 4RUNNER
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
∗
∗
∗
∗
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
5
1
2
3
4
: w/ Daytime Running Light
: Limited
: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
8
7
6
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
PWS
TRLY
6
L–R
2
A A
H
H
H
1
2
R
R
1 IP2
A A
9 BB1
H
R
R
R
19 1A
6 1E
R
(∗2)
A
22 1J
W(∗3)
R
W(∗4)
L–R
J35
Junction Connector
1
D11
Door Courtesy Light
Rear RH
C B
E
9 1A
8 BB1
Y
D9
Door Courtesy Light
Front RH
P
2
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
R
N
O
W
(w/ Vanity Light)
2
R
L
M
1
R
(∗2)
K
4 1A
(w/ Vanity Light)
R
J
9 IP1
R
H
I
1
E
R
G
W
(w/ Vanity Light)
F
2
R
W
(∗4)
W(∗3)
D
E
W–R
L–W
L–Y
Y–R
R–L
R
R
B–R
B–Y(∗1)
R–B
R–B
W
W
W–B
DOOR
C
5
1 A (∗3)
W–B
B
OFF
ON
DOOR
OFF
ON
Moon Roof Control ECU
< 24–2>
TOWING TAIL Relay
< 27–3>
W–R
B
1
UP
R–G
W
L–O
L–O
W–L
L–W
L
A
2
RCYL
22 B
I17
Ignition Key Cylinder Light
V7
Vanity Light RH
3
1 B (∗4)
6
V6
Vanity
Light LH
2 B (∗4)
L2
Luggage
Compartment Light
3 B
I20(A), (B)
Interior Light
3 A
2 A (∗3)
P7
Personal Light
1 1H
1
E
W(∗3)
LG
W
(∗3)
W–B
25 1J
1
PCYL
25 A
B1
Back Door Power
Window Control SW
W
W(∗4)
COM
19 B
3
DOWN
9 1K
W
(w/ Vanity Light)
W(∗3)
W(∗3)
2
2 1F
W–B
W(∗4)
W(∗4)
10 1K
18 1A
W(∗4)
W(∗3)
L
1 1C
2 1H
12 1A
W
(∗3)
1 1A
W
(∗3)
1
30A POWER
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
16 1E
8 1A
1
10A SECU/HORN
Taillight and
Illumination
System< 10–2>
5
7 1A
BUP
10 B
Y
2
BDN
8 B
B–Y
3
TAIL
Relay
ILE
13
Y–R
1
GND2
16
B–L
5
2
4
POWER Relay
3
GND1
21
18
R–W
E
J6
Junction Connector
R–W
LG
W–L
W–R
W
L–O
W–R
L–O
L–Y
Y–R
R–L
R
R
B–R
B–Y(∗1)
R–B
R–B
W
W
W–B
W–B
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
M
433
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
∗ 2 : Limited
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
9
12
11
10
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
W
B
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
S
T
U
V
B
A
R–W
W–B
B–R
R–W
LG
W–L
W–R
W
L–O
W–R
L–O
B–R
R–W
LG
W–L
W–R
W
L–O
W–R
L–O
L–Y
Y–R
R–L
R
R
B–R
B–Y(∗1)
R–B
R–B
W
W
W–B
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B(∗1)
W–B
R
R–G
R–W
G
23 IC4
R–G
J25
Junction
Connector
A
A
R–W
E
F
R–G
D
R–W
Y–R
C
2
H1
Headlight LH
(High)
1
R–L
1
W–B
2
J6
Junction Connector
B
2
R–L
R–B
A
1
H4
Headlight RH (Low)
Y–R
Y–R
E
1
2
2
W–B
(∗1)
Y–R
Y–R
E
A
J7
Junction
Connector
R
R
R
(∗2)
E
2
22 IC4
R
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
3 IE1
2
W–B
E A
W
H A
D B
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction Connector
B–Y
(∗1)
B–R
B–R
Y–R
Y–R
L–Y
H A
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction Connector
F B
20 IC4
2
2
R–Y
8 1F
9 BA1
1
19 IC4
H2
Headlight LH (Low)
28 1J
2
1
2
W–B
(∗1)
8 1J
E
9
Y–R
(∗1)
20 1E
TFR
1
B–Y
(∗1)
R
2 1C
TFL
IG
6
2
HAZ
2
10A HEAD(HI RH)
TSR
4
10A HEAD(HI LH)
DRL TSL
10
10A HEAD(LO RH)
8
10A HEAD(LO LH)
7
R–B
2
2
D2
Daytime Running
Light Relay
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
10A ECU–IG
12
R
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
HF2
20 C
8 1B
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning Light
System< 8–2> < 8–3>
1
2 BL1
4 IO3
A
13 IA1
1
R
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
2 BM1
2
2
R
1
S34
Step Light
Rear LH
S32
Step Light
Front LH
1
1
2
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
S35
Step Light
Rear RH
R
(∗2)
S33
Step Light Front RH
2
1
15A IG1
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
P–G
1 BL1
D10
Door Courtesy Light Rear LH
4 IE1
D8
Door Courtesy Light Front LH
1 BM1
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
W–R
(∗2)
5 IO3
HRLY
17
1
C A
Y–G
C A
8 BA1
DRL
7 A
W
9 IA1
10
R–B
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction Connector
SIG
1
LG–R
(∗1)
P–G
C B
WIG
15A RR WSH
LCYL
21 B
W–R
(∗2)
DCYL
26 A
W–G
LP
6 B
W–B
Front Left
Fender
EB
W–B
Y–R
R–L
W–B
W–B
W–B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
434
(Cont. next page)
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
13
∗ 1 : w/ Daytime Running Light
16
15
14
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
HEAD
1 C
TAIL
8 C
9 IH1
G–R
2
W–B
8
A
HF
2
HU
OFF
17
B
7
2
1
2
1
B 3F
A 3C
B 3F
B 3F A 3C
G
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction Connector
W–B
W–B
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
R–G
R–W
W–B
W–B
B–R
R–W
LG
W–L
W–R
W
L–O
W–R
L–O
B–R
B–R
R–W
W–R
W
L–O
W–R
L–O
B–R
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
R
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B(∗1)
Y–R
R–L
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
IG
J5
Junction
Connector
EA
Front Right
Fender
A
Right Kick
Panel
W–B
IK
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
A
A
W–B
B
C
W
J37
Junction
Connector
M
435
Left Kick
Panel
W–B
W
A
R–G
W–B
J
4
R
W–B
C12
Combination SW
R–L
H
I
HORN Relay
< 26–1>
E3
Engine Hood Courtesy SW
W–B
ON
W–B
F
P–G
B
W–B
E
G
GR–G
LG
R
OFF
R–G
D
B
6 IC3
12 IC3
W–B
E
A
12
R–W
D
X
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
R–G
W–B
Flash
W–B
R–G
C
B
A
E
A
3
DSWH
34
G
W–B
B
B
R–G
PBEW SIND
+B2
3
1
High
R–G
R–G
B
1
IND
25
G–R
Low
11
B
7
F2
Front Fog Light RH
W–B
G
E
A
GND
5
G
R–G
A B
2
F1
Front Fog Light LH
W–B
G
10
IN1
2
J3
Junction Connector
W–B
R–G
Fog
Light
SW
R–G
1
Dimmer SW
2
A B
3
G
R–W
1
IG+
2
Y–R
AUTO
A
FR FOG
Relay
G
Head
H3
Headlight RH
(High)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
J15(B)
Junction Connector
Light
Control
SW
Tail
5
HORN
P–G
12
W–B
EL
W–B
T
DIND
W–L
16
14
H
11
GR–G
13
DFSW
G–R
G–O
G
R
10
BFG LFG HL
4
2
T5
Theft Deterrent ECU
D3
Defogger SW
Passenger Seat Belt
Warning Light
Security Indicator Light
G–R
(Except Limited)
2
IC3
G–R
LG
TOUT
6 A
G
R–L
DIND
5 B
G–R
10 IH1
DEFSW
1 B
R–W
G–O
G
R
R–W
8 IH1
HF
7 C
G–O
G
R
1 IH1
A
3 C
(Cont. next page)
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
17
∗ 5 : w/ Option Connector (TVIP ECU) Except Limited
20
19
18
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
MPX3 KSW
26 C 14 C
T5
Theft Deterrent ECU
1
IG
+B1
MPX1
2
31
BR–Y
B B
V
B
10
IP2
C
C
W
5 BA1
5 IA2
R–G
R–W
B–R
R–W
B–R
R–W
W–R
W
L–O
W–R
L–O
B–R
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
R
W–B
II
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
G
L–O
W–R
L–O
A
D
1
B
W
B–R
R–G
R–W
A
W–B
4
J24
Junction
Connector
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
B
W
U
L–Y
A
B
S
T
B–R
(∗5)
9
IP2
W
W–R
(∗5)
Transponder Key Computer
< 5–20> < 6–20>
W
R
A 3D
R–B
C
C
W
Q
B–R
B 3E B 3E
5
P9
Power Window Control
SW Front RH
J7
Junction Connector
C
W
O
P
A 3D
L–R
L
M
N
B–R
D A
3
2
W–B
K
L
D A
5
IP2
2
W–B
I
J
G A
2
K3
Unlock Warning SW
G A
1
+B
M
G–Y
(∗5)
BR–Y
(∗5)
B 3E
3
IG
W–R
(∗5)
H
B A
4
MPX1
B–R
(∗5)
G
B A
KSW
R
1
W–B
F
B A
E A
G–Y
E
A 3D
W–R
D
W
J12(A)
Junction
Connector
B–R
B–R
C
D A
G–Y
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
G
B
A B
W–R
B–R
T1
Theft Deterrent Horn
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
G A
A
B B
C B
BR–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
A B
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
G–Y
BR–Y
W–B
BR–B
2 IN1
KSW
12
G–Y
10
2
L–B
E
29
Z1
Option Connector
(TVIP ECU)
P13
Power Window Motor Front RH
G–Y
SH–
1
G–Y
BR–Y
G–Y
W–B
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
R
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
436
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
21
24
23
22
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
W/L 1
24 C
D17
Door Lock Control SW Front LH
Power Window Master SW
L–R
L–R
L–Y
A
W/L 2
22 C
PD
L–Y
B2
BW
RRU
7
RRD
R–W
4
5
PLS
3
6
PLS2
E
L–W
L–O
J38
Junction
Connector
B
B
B
W
P11
Power Window Control
SW Rear RH
4
P10
Power Window Control
SW Rear LH
P12
Power Window Motor Front LH
B
4 IA2
W–B
W–B
R–G
R–W
B–R
R–W
G
G
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
R
B
3
B–R
R–W
L–O
W–R
L–O
A
W–B
Z
2
U SSRB
W–B
Y
1
1
D
4 IA1
L–O
W
X
G–W
V
L
5
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
W–B
U
UL
8
W–B
S
T
E
1
W–B
Q
W–G
P
R
2
BR–B
N
O
W–L
M
W–R
L
P14
Power Window Motor
Rear LH
L
K
2
L–B
J
5
G–R
I
G–R
H
3
W
G
B
W
B–R
R–G
R–W
1
M
6 BA1
G–W
F
G–W
E
W
2
17
14
5 IA1
1
7 BA1
PLS2 GND
3
M
4
5
BB1
L–B
C
5
G
C
W
6 BB1
G–B
J33
Junction Connector
D
C
W
P15
Power Window Motor
Rear RH
L
G
G–B
L–O
B–R
L–Y
L–R
L–R
L–Y
L–Y
L–R
C
W
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
VCC PLS
6 IA2
2
M
DU
4
L
9 IA2
DD
9
L–B
10 IA2
2
7 BB1
RLD
10
G
11 IA2
12
L
2 IA2
RLU
16
R–L
12 IA1
18
B
7 IA2
11
R
12 IA2
B
6
B
A A
PU
13
B
B A
15
R–B
B A
C B
R
A A
B B
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction Connector
B
W–R
L–O
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
R
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
M
437
(Cont. next page)
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
25
28
27
26
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
L1
UL1
15
20
5 1K
1 1K
3 1K
B–W
LSR
5
9 1L
18 1L
6 1L
23 1L
11 1L
15 1K
22 1L
10 1L
W
L–B
L–R
W
L–B
L–R
L–R
L–B
L–R
3
16 1L
10 BA1
11 BA1
12 BA1
10 BB1
11 BB1
12 BB1
B–W
L–O
L–W
L–O
L–W
6 IP1
6 IA1
5 IP1
8 IA1
7 IA1
13 IA2
7 IP1
8 IA2
7 IP2
2 IP2
L–R
L–B
W
L–R
L–B
W
B–W
B–R
B
B–W
B–R
W
G
L
W–B
L–W
L–O
9
10
8
1
7
4
1
7
4
6
1
M
M
8
6
1
D20
9
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear LH
Door Lock Motor
Rear LH
4
M
D21
9
W–B
D19
Door Lock Detection
SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor
Front RH
4
M
W–B
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Lock Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor Front LH
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Door Lock Detection
SW Rear RH
Door Lock Motor
Rear RH
4 IP2
4 BA1
W–B
C
D
E
F
G
H
W–B
R–G
R–W
B–R
R–W
B–R
R–W
G
I
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–R
L–O
W–B
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
LG
R
LG
R
W–R
L–O
C
D
E
F
W–B
L
W–B
K
A
B
G
W–B
J
U
4 BB1
W–B
W–B
R–G
R–W
W–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B
ACT–
24
D
L–O
A
ACT+
23
L–B
A
LSWP
30 A
L
R
D
ACTD
10 A
W–R
6
LSWD
21 A
G
L
D
5
A
UL3
12 A
D18
Door Lock Control
SW Front RH
Lock
Unlock
A
L–O
L–W
J6
Junction
Connector
L2
19
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
438
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
29
∗ 6 : w/ Driving Position Memory
32
31
30
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
41 IE1
10 IC4
F A
F A
1 IC3
DRLP
12 C
DCY2
11 C
W–L
RRCY
12 B
KSWO
15 C
V–G
W–L
R–Y
R
39 IE1
RLCY
11 B
V–Y
H B
F A
38 IE1
PCTY
24 B
P–L
J7
Junction Connector
D
D
R
D
V–Y
37 IE1
A
B
C
6 IO3
R
1
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
1
R–G
R–W
R–L
R
R–W
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–B
2
1
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
1
1
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
DOME
Relay
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
2
2
P–L
P–B
2
R
W–B
W–B
A A
R–B
5
E
A A
Transponder Key Computer
< 5–20> < 6–20>
2
+B
3
A A
R–B
5
1
W–B
Position Control ECU and SW
< 33–2>
PRG
R–B
(∗6)
RDA
R
R
3
R
2
R
G–O
L–R
D7
Door Control
Receiver
W3
Wireless Door
Lock Buzzer
2
DCTY
23 B
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction Connector
R
Suspension Control
ECU< 18–6>
Y–B
P–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
LMRY
3 A
P–B
PRG
3 B
R–B
6 1B
RDA
4 B
R
10 1B
ACTY
20 B
G–O
7
L–R
BZR2
9
R–G
BZR
D
E
F
A B
A
B
C
D
E
F
W–B
R–G
R–W
W–B
B–R
R–W
B–R
G
G
W–B
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
R
W–R
L–O
W–B
W–B
W–R
L–O
W–B
W–B
R–L
R
R
B–R
R
B–R
W–B
LG
R
LG
R
BO
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
W–B
W–B
BL
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
M
439
Rear Pillar
LH
G
(Cont. next page)
∗ 6 : w/ Driving Position Memory
∗ 7 : w/o Driving Position Memory
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
33
36
35
34
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
DBKL
13 A
10A MIR HEATER
30A DEFOG
B–L
18 IC4
4 IC4
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
D A
B–L
Y–G
Y–G
(1GR–FE)
Y–G
(2UZ–FE)
Y–G
Engine Control
Module< 6–12>
Y–G
E B
2
Engine
Control
Module< 5–15>
B–L
W–B
B–R
10 BD1
W–B
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
EE
ED
W–B
(∗6)
W–B
(∗7)
LG
R
1 BK1
W–B
(∗6)
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
BL
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
A
B
C
W–B
W–R
L–O
W–B
W–B
BR
(2UZ–FE)
S
B
H A
BR
(1GR–FE)
R
D A
2
2
D
W–B
Q
R
B–R
W–B
D A
2
3 BH1
W–B
P
A A
B
R
O
R21(A), R22(B)
Rear Window Defogger
W–B
N
Airbag Sensor
Assembly< 20–7>
J53
Junction
Connector
M
A B
7 IM1
W–B
(∗6)
K
4
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
J
L
R
W–R
L–O
W–B
W–B
F B
H A
1 A
1 B
W–B
(∗7)
G
Y–G
B15
Buckle SW LH
L–R
BR
I
W–B
B–R
10 BK1
3
R–L
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
H
12 B
K B
G
R–L
R–W
G
13 B
B
13 C
D A
C B
7 BH1
L
(∗6)
10 D
C A
1
36 IE1
G–Y
(∗6)
15 C
26 IE1
L
(∗7)
12 D
4 BD1
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
13 D
R–G
LG
R–W
18 B
1
D A
G–Y
16 C
D A
G–Y
(∗7)
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
17 A
2
Y–G
G–Y
Front Fog
8 C
R
F
19 B
V–Y
E
Head (USA)
Beam
Door
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
D
R–G
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction Connector
G–Y
V–Y
B B
B–R
3 1B
R
W–L
Driver' s Seat Belt
C
Buzzer
6
G–Y
B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
A
V–G
RDEF
E
F
G
H
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
440
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
L–O
W–B
B–R
L
B
W–R
R
LG–B
LG–B
J39
Junction Connector
W–R
Turn Signal Flasher
Relay< 8–3> < 9–3>
STOP LP CTRL Relay
< 11–3>
Combination Meter
< 31–5>
Generator
< 4–3>
Park/Neutral
Position SW
< 13–12> < 14–9>
Data Link Connector 3
< 5–7> < 6–7>
LG
LG
LG
P4
Parking Brake SW
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–3>
Radio and Player with
Display< 28–9>
J39
Junction Connector
B–R
F
E
L–R
GR
G–B
R–Y
BR–W
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction Connector
BR–R
LG
GR–R
D24
Diode
(Rear Wiper)
B–O
GR–R
LG–B
LG–B
Rear Wiper and
Washer SW
M4
Mirror Heater RH
W–B
Washer
W–B
W–B
H
OFF
M3
Mirror Heater LH
G
G–B
G–B
F
W–R
L–O
W–B
W–B
E
B–L
B–L
W–B
D
W2
Washer Motor
B–L
WR EW +1R C1R
F
2
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C
W–B
B–R
B
HI
13
10
12
BR–W
BR–R
20 1J
2 1E
1 1E
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
1
C A
C A
C14
Combination
SW
5
5
2
B B
4
LO
B–L
A
B
A B
17 1J
3
E
3 IC3
6 BD1
B A
B A
1
B
Washer
4
4
7 IH1
18 IP1
18 IA1
7 BD1
5 BD1
GR–R
40 IE1
9 BD1
1 1B
J6
Junction
Connector
M
BDR
4 A
2
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
B 4(A), B 5(B), B 6(C)
Body ECU
BECU
5 A
GND
3 A
MPX2
1 A
8
MPX2
23 A
HAZ
3
SPD
STPI
14
L
14 A
P
17 B
OBD2
17 C
PKB
2 B
RWINT
9 C
RWON
10 C
WMTR
40
39
38
37
SIG
6 A
B
(Cont. next page)
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
M
441
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (B E A N )
41
44
43
42
B 8(A), B 9(B)
Back Door ECU
HSW–
22 B
BDUP BDDN IC+
IC2
13 B 25 B 11 B 17 B
HALF FULL POS ACT+ ACT– LSE
6 B
7 B
8 B 15 B 14 B 21 B
1
2
M
1
3
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
M
5
Return
Position
Furthest
Position
B11
Back Door Power Window Motor
Stop
2
R23
Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Position SW
4
M
B7
Back Door Courtesy SW
Back Door Half Latch SW
Back Door Lock Detection SW
Back Door Lock Motor
B–R
4
L–R
6
L–B
5
BR–W
WIP–
1 B
G–Y
3
E
WIP+
2 B
R–G
6
PLS2
W
3 B
BR–B
PLS
P
12 B
P–B
2
SGND
18 B
G–R
1
L–W
5
G SSRB
B–O
B10
Back Door Opener SW
4
R
IC1
IC–
16 B 23 B
W–R
Y–G
1
2
R–B
Y–B
LG–R
T10
Tailgate Control SW
1
HSW+
10 B
V–W
2
V–Y
GR–R
LG–B
3
UP
5 B
R–G
DOWN
4 B
Y–G
E
19 B
3
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
442
7 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
443
T u rn S ig n a l a n d H a z a rd W a rn in g L ig h t (w / D a y tim e R u n n in g L ig h t)
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
B–Y
ACC
D2
Daytime Running Light Relay
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
B
IG1 4
B–Y
IG
L–Y
1
TFL
TFR
4
2
E
9
TSL
TSR
7
8
HAZ
10
2 IH1
5 1J
9 1F
15 1F
3 IH1
15 1J
A
D
L–Y
2
Turn LH
6
Turn RH
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
6
3
Turn
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
Turn
Towing Converter
Relay< 27–4>
W–B
2
2
10
L–Y
L–B
3
W–B
2
6
3
W–B
F6
Front Turn Signal
Light RH
Y–R
F5
Front Turn Signal
Light LH
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
3
L–B
2
L–Y
RH
2
H11
Hazard SW
Turn
Y–R
140A ALT
15A TRN–HAZ
F B
1
TR
LH
2
H A
TB
2 1G
L–B
D
J39
Junction
Connector
A
A
3
TL
C12
Combination SW
R–Y
R–B
J7
Junction
Connector
A
1
3 1G
L–Y
L–B
W
G–Y
G–B
Y–R
50A AM1
1
2
23 1J
D
A
2
3
Body ECU
< 7–39>
2
1
TRR
L–Y
14 1J
2
2
TRL
5
L–B
8 1J
G–Y
Multiplex Communication
System< 7–10>
W–L
1 IN1
B–Y
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
15A
IG1
42 IC4
G–B
R–Y
R–B
Y–R
W–B
2 1C
2
DRL
12
W
I18
Ignition SW
20 IC4
4
3
2
6
2 AM1
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
444
8 4RUNNER
W–B
B
W–B
C10
Combination
Meter
13
B
A A
A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
Right Kick
Panel
IK
J24
BR
(2UZ–FE)
IG
A
BR
(1GR–FE)
Left Kick
Panel
J37
Junction
Connector
W–B
Front Right
Fender
A
A
7 IM1
A B
W–B
EA
J5
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
W–B
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
EB
A A
B
3F
B 3F
Front Left
Fender
A A
BR
E A
B 3F
J15
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
Battery
A
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
D B
EE
ED
Junction
Connector
II
Instrument
Panel
Brace RH
Floor Seat
Crossmember
LH
BL
BO
Rear
Pillar
LH
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder
Block
Left Bank
Cylinder
Head
9 4RUNNER
T u rn S ig n a l a n d H a z a rd W a rn in g L ig h t (w /o D a y tim e R u n n in g L ig h t)
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
B–Y
T9
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
4
+B
ACC
2 AM1
6 IF1
IG1 4
IG
LL
1
GND
EL
7
5
ER
EHW
6
8
W
G–Y
G–B
W–B
L–Y
Y–R
8 IF1
10 IF1
5 IF1
Y–R
42 IC4
A
15 1F
L–Y
W–B
W–B
C10
Combination
Meter
A A
13
BR
A A
Turn LH
Turn RH
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
Turn
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
Turn
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
J24
BR
(2UZ–FE)
IK
A
BR
(1GR–FE)
Right Kick
Panel
J37
Junction
Connector
W–B
IG
A
A
7 IM1
A B
W–B
Left Kick
Panel
J5
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
W–B
EE
ED
Junction
Connector
II
Instrument
Panel Brace
RH
Floor Seat
Crossmember
LH
BL
BO
Rear
Pillar
LH
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder
Block
Left Bank
Cylinder
Head
M
445
Front Right
Fender
6
B
3F
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
W–B
EA
10
A
A
EB
3
A A
B 3F
Front Left
Fender
L–B
L–B
Towing Converter
Relay< 27–4>
B 3F
J15
Junction
Connector
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
E A
A
6
6
L–B
D
2 1G
L–Y
A
J39
Junction
Connector
D
2
3
W–B
2
L–Y
2
D B
Battery
H11
Hazard SW
3
2
W–B
2
LH
RH
C12
Combination SW
Turn
3
TR
3 1G
L–Y
L–B
W
G–Y
G–B
A
A
3
TB
W–B
F6
Front Turn Signal Light RH
B
B
R–Y
R–B
2
1
TL
F5
Front Turn Signal Light LH
Y–R
2
9 1F
3 IH1
D
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
F B
1
2
2 IH1
Y–R
140A ALT
15A TRN–HAZ
H A
5 1J
15 1J
2
1
1 IN1
J7
Junction
Connector
50A AM1
2
23 1J
Body ECU
< 7–39>
2
A
L–Y
14 1J
2
1
3 IF1
L–B
W
G–Y
G–B
W–B
R–Y
2
R–B
Y–R
8 1J
L–Y
L–B
7 IF1
W
9 IF1
G–Y
2 IF1
G–B
4 IF1
W–B
W–L
B–Y
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1 IF1
15A
IG1
L–Y
L–B
2 1C
20 IC4
2
L–B
L–Y
B–Y
I18
Ignition SW
LR
3
R
R
B–R
J16(A), J17(B)
Junction
Connector
G
G
G
G
G
G
W–G
W–G
W–G
R25
Roll Sensing of Curtain
Shield Airbag Cutoff SW
W–G
A42
Auto LSD SW
M2
Main SW
W–B
D4
Diff. Lock SW
W–B
C13
Combination SW
B10
License Plate Light
RH
LH
R15
Rear Combination Light RH
Stop/Tail
R14
Rear Combination Light LH
Stop/Tail
W–B
W–B
W–B
J16(A), J17(B)
Junction
Connector
W–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Audio System
< 28–9> < 29–6> < 30–5>
C12
Combination SW
F
W–B
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
Rear Pillar
LH
BO
BL
H
W–B
G
W–G
B
A A
G
G
G
G
F6
Front Parking Light RH
F5
Front Parking Light LH
G
A B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
Head
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
Front Right
Fender
EA
EB
G
G
G
Light
Control SW
A B
A B
A A
A A
A B
A B
B
16
1
1
1
W–G
2
B 6(C)
Body ECU
14
2
1
1
2
2
2
A B
A B
A A
A A
A A
A A
2
2
H
EL
T
10A TAIL
TAIL Relay
50A J/B
30A AM2
50A AM1
OFF
Front Left
Fender
IG
Left Kick
Panel
J5
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
Battery
Tail
2
G
L–W
R
W–L
Short Pin
2
10
10 BD1
8 IH1
1
B B
B B
W
TAIL
G
10A DOME
TRLY
6
6
140A
ALT
3
1
3
2
11 1B
9 1B
18
4
4
4
B B
B B
B B
5 1L
1 1C
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
2 BH1
13 1F
B A
B A
B
G
B
B
I18
Ignition SW
3 BH1
8 C
2
2 BD1
E
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
446
IG2 6
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
7 AM2
B
L–W
1
5
1
2
2
2
2
L–Y
J39
Junction
Connector
ST2
G
G
IG1 4
C
B–R
ACC
10 IC4
B
L–Y
A
R
4
3
2
1
D
G
2
2 AM1
2
T a illig h t a n d Illu m in a tio n
P o w e r S o u rc e
B A
2
(Cont. next page)
10 4RUNNER
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
F11
4WD Control SW
C7
Cigarette Lighter
Illumination
W–B
A38
Ashtray Illumination
W–B
W–G
A22
A/T Shift Lever Illumination
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
B1
Back Door Power Window
Control SW
W–G
H11
Hazard SW
S5
Seat Heater SW RH
S4
Seat Heater SW LH
C15
Cup Holder Illumination
W–G
D5
Downhill Assist Control SW
W–G
H19
Height Control
Mode Select SW
W–G
W–G
Engine Control
Module< 5–15>
< 6–12>
W–G
W–G
W–G
W–G
G
G
G
G
G
G
W–G
A 3F
A 3F
H12
Height Control SW
W–G
W–G
(∗2)
W–G
(∗1)
R12
Radio and Player with Display
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
A 3F
C 3E
D3
Defogger SW
Heater Control Panel
R 1(A), R 2(B), R 3(C)
Radio and Player
5 C (∗4)
G
G
G
(∗2)
G
(∗1)
G
12
A 3F
A 3F
1
4
5
5
5
2
2
2
1
ILL–
ILL–
I B
C 3E
3
2
2
4 IR1
2 IR1
1
W–G
H
W–G
F
W–B
G
W–G
W–B
H
W–G
G
10
ILL–
12 A (∗3)
9
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2 A (∗3)
3 IR1
1 IR1
1
1
2
2
4
ILL+
G
6
6
1
1
1
2
ILL+
10 B (∗4)
ILL+ (∗5)
ILL+B(∗6)
2
D A
D 3D
D 3D
D 3D
D 3D
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
D
3D
D
3D
G
E
D 3D
D 3D
W–G
W–G
F
G
E
G
D
G
D
B–R
B
B–R
C
L–Y
C
L–Y
B
∗ 4 : 6 Speaker
∗ 5 : w/ CD Changer
∗ 6 : w/o CD Changer
∗ 1 : w/ Navigation System
∗ 2 : w/o Navigation System
∗ 3 : Except 6 Speaker
T a illig h t a n d Illu m in a tio n
A
R
8
7
6
5
R
A
(Cont. next page)
10 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
G
M
447
T a illig h t a n d Illu m in a tio n
A
B
L–Y
12
11
10
L–Y
B–R
R
C
9
R
G
6 1D
2 1C
J7
Junction
Connector
B–R
L–Y
D
∗ 7 : Except USA
D
D
R
7. 5A
GAUGE
15A
IG1
E
4 1G
8 1J
J7
Junction
Connector
G
15
16
7
13
Tail (∗7)
Illumination
H A
Illumination
H A
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
C A
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
G3
Glove Box Light
A B
C A
9
Y–R
G
1
C10
Combination Meter
R
A
A
R–L
G
Y–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
F B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
H A
G
2
G
W–B
Y–R
G
R13
B 3F
4
Rheostat
BR
–
3
W–G
W–B
W–G
E B
7 IM1
A A
A A
W–G
W–G
W–B
W–B
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
Instrument
Panel
Brace RH
A
BR
(1GR–FE)
W–B
W–G
BR
(2UZ–FE)
H
W–B
W–B
G
W–G
E
5
W–G
6
IG
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
ILL–
B 3F
F
1
T
B
3F
ED
EE
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
Right Kick
Panel
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
448
10 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
11 4RUNNER
G–Y
Taillight System
< 10–3>
G–Y
Body ECU
< 7–39>
Y–R
G–Y
G–Y
G–W
G–Y
10A STOP
G–Y
(∗2)
H18(A)
High Mounted
Stop Light
H18(B)
High Mounted
Stop Light
W–B
(∗2)
Stop/Tail
R15
Rear Combination Light RH
G–Y
G–B
G–Y
G–Y
G–Y
LG
J4
Junction
Connector
G–B
J4
Junction
Connector
G–B
G–B
G–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
G–Y
G–Y
G–Y
G–Y
B
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–3>
W–B
W–B
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–3>
Shift Lock Control ECU
< 30–7>
G–Y
Suspension
Control ECU< 18–5>
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–3>
Towing Brake
Controller< 27–3>
Stop/Tail
R14
Rear Combination Light LH
STOP LP CTRL
Relay
S12
Stop Light SW
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B
BO
Rear Pillar
LH
BL
M
449
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
J40(A), J41(B)
A B
A A
A A
A A
A A
2 B
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
Y–R
Engine Control
Module
< 5–17> < 6–18>
G–W
140A ALT
15 IC3
Junction Connector
Battery
B
3 BD1
50A AM1
2
10 BD1
6
6
E
E
E
B
E 3C
E
1
2 A
2
2
2
2
12 1J
W–B
(∗1)
B
E 3C
16 1F
4
4
1
4
G–Y
(∗1)
2
2
1 B
2
3
1
D
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–L
E 3C
1
Y–R
B A
B A
B A
J1
Junction
Connector
C B
20 1E
G–Y
15A
IG1
1 A
H A
B
2
G–Y
I18
Ignition SW
C B
E
24 1E
2
1
5
2
E B
1
1
Towing Converter
Relay< 27–4>
2 1C
ACC
D
E
2
2
G–W
2
2
IG1 4
2 AM1
4
3
2
1
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Spoiler
∗ 2 : w/o Rear Spoiler
S to p L ig h t
P o w e r S o u rc e
L–Y
P o w e r S o u rc e
B a c k – U p L ig h t
1
3
2
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
R–Y
2 1C
B
I18
Ignition SW
J33
1 IM1
W–L
R–Y
Junction
Connector
B
R–Y
15A
IG1
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
2
8 1J
2 1L
10 1F
2
R–Y
Y–R
Y–R
A
J7
Junction
Connector
2
2 IM1
50A
AM1
J40(A), J41(B)
B B
A
Junction Connector
Y–R
Y–R
C A
1
H
H
A
3
2
Trailer Socket
< 27–4>
2
Back–Up
6
2
R15
Rear Combination
Light RH
Y–R
1
Back–Up
140A
ALT
R–Y
J25
Junction
Connector
R–Y
J20
Junction
Connector
R–Y
2
C A
C A
A
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
R
6
2
W–B
W–B
B
B
A A
A A
A A
W–B
Battery
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction Connector
A B
W–B
BO
Rear Pillar
LH
BL
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
4
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
450
12 4RUNNER
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
451
E le c tro n ic a lly C o n tro lle d T ra n s m is s io n a n d A /T In d ic a to r (2 U Z – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
R
H A
B–R
R–L
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
6 1D
W–L
R
D
J7
Junction
Connector
D
R
L–Y
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
F B
4
3
2
10A
IGN
7. 5A
GAUGE
ST2
R
2
10 IC4
11 1J
I18
Ignition SW
2
4 1G
R–L
GR
W–G
2
T4
Turbine
Speed
Sensor
B–O
B A
B A
B A
2
2
S1
S2
10 B
SLU–
14 B
27 B
NT+
SL1+
19 B
SL1–
18 B
34 B
NT–
SL2+
17 B
SL2–
16 B
26 B
SP2+
THO1
24 B
SP2–
THO2
32 B
11
3
10
SL2+
SL2–
9
BR
R
L
Y
V
OT+
OT2+
L
SL1–
O
SL1+
LG
SB
SLU–
GR
B
SLU+
W–B
B
11 IC4
L
O
B
OT–
EB
Front Left
Fender
OT2–
1
BR
Battery
2
BR
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
BR
4
SLT–
B
2
E2
28 A
L
12
Y–G
5
B–R
13
B–W
6
SLT+
G
SR
B–Y
14
S2
G–B
7
S1
R–W
15
8
R–B
A B
W
C A
SLU+
15 B
L–R
B B
SLT–
12 B
LG–B
1
SLT+
13 B
P–L
1
A B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
SR
9 B
W–L
GR
1
B A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
Short Pin
1
20A
EFI
35 B
IGSW
11 B
2
10A
ETCS
R–L
+B2
2 E
2
30A
AM2
9 E
+BM
B
B
2
2
L–Y
2
W–B
2
2
+B
2
1 E
B
2
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
7 E
BATT
Y–R
3 E
2
2
L
GR
R
B
W
2
8 E
Junction
Connector
B–O
3
B B
J 8(A)
MREL
2
13 IC4
GR
2
12 IC4
L
EFI
Relay
1
1
35 IC4
1
W–R
2
1
W–G
140A ALT
10A DOME
2
5
1
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
1
2
V11
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically
Controlled
Transmission)
50A
AM1
B–O
R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
L
A
B
C
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
452
(Cont. next page)
13 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
13 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
E le c tro n ic a lly C o n tro lle d T ra n s m is s io n a n d A /T In d ic a to r (2 U Z – F E )
A
B
C
5
R
8
7
6
L–Y
L–Y
A
R–L
B–L
G
17 A
M–
21 A
GE01
30 A
THW
29 A
VG
22 A
E2G
THA
VPA
19 E
VPA2
26 E
27 E
VCPA VCP2
ME01
20 E
EPA
21 E
8 D
EPA2
SPD
OILW
29 D
3 B
15 E
STP
9 D
20 D
L
4
R
D
3
2
11 D
21 D
19 D
10 D
G B
B B
3
ATL
AT4
AT2
ATD
5
2
G–R
L
L
BR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
1 IM2
V
R–Y
P
W–B
G–R
V
W–B
R–Y
7 IM1
W
BR
A B
G
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
W
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
EC
EOM
9 C
35 D
18 E
G
4 A
4
P–L
7 B
M+
D 3C
B–L
8 C
E04
5 A
S6
Transmission Control SW
4WD
VTA2
D A
G
1 C
19 A
VTA1
G
4 B
E1
20 A
B–L
E03
VC
G 3C
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
23 A
D 3C
B–L
E02
6 A
34 D
CANH CANL
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
7 A
33 D
R
6 B
E01
TC
F A
R–L
E05
23 E
STA
G 3C
G
11 C
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
D B
B–L
12 C
STAR/ STSW
NSW
G 3C
G
B–L
B A
B B
W–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
D A
Engine Control System
< 5–8> < 5–11> < 5–12> < 5–13> < 5–14> < 5–15> < 5–16> < 5–17> < 5–18>
8 B
D 3C
13 C
15 A
15 C
A A
C 8(A), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
16 C
BR
W–B
W–B
A/T OIL TEMP
14 D
15 D
L
2
B
C
D
E
F
G
A
J37
Junction
Connector
EE
EE
Rear Side of
Cylinder Block
IK
Right Kick
Panel
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
M
453
Rear Side of
Cylinder Block
∗ 1 : w/ Navigation System
∗ 2 : w/ Driving Position Memory
E le c tro n ic a lly C o n tro lle d T ra n s m is s io n a n d A /T In d ic a to r (2 U Z – F E )
9
A
Y–R
L–Y
2 1C
A
2
IM1
Y–R
Y–R
J25
Junction
Connector
H
12
11
10
A
P1
2
Park/Neutral Position SW
RB
H
Y–R
15A
IG1
2L
DL
NL
RL
PL
8
3
7
9
1
6
G–B
R–Y
G–W
V
L
G–R
A
Y–R
20 IM2
D
3E
9 IM1
21 IM2
10 IM1
8 IM1
1 IM1
V
Radio and
Player with
Display
< 28–9>
G–R
D 3E
V
G–B
G–B
G–B
(∗2)
R–Y
G–B
G–B
R–Y
(∗1)
R–Y
G–W
V
C B
I A
D B
B A
C B
B A
B A
2 1L
2 1J
C A
C A
E A
A B
E A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
C A
J35(A)
Junction Connector
E B
C A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction Connector
A A
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
F B
A A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction Connector
C A
C B
G–B
G–B
R–Y
R–Y
G–W
G–W
L
V
4WD Control
ECU< 19–3>
Body ECU
< 7–39>
G
H A
V
F
G–R
H A
L
E
E B
L
D
H A
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
A B
E A
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction Connector
E A
C
G–W
NSSL
S6
Transmission Control SW
B
L
V
10
L
9
NSSD
G–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator<15–3>
J7
Junction
Connector
8 1J
LL
Position Control ECU and SW
<33–2>
A
J20
Junction
Connector
R–Y
W
G
16 D
3
17 D
4
18 D
19 D
D
N
C 8(A), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
1 C
R
20 D
P
C A
C A
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
454
13 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
455
E le c tro n ic a lly C o n tro lle d T ra n s m is s io n a n d A /T In d ic a to r (1 G R – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
R
L–Y
ACC
R
2 AM1
B–R
IG1 4
R–L
L–Y
6 1D
W–L
10 IC4
R
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
10A
IGN
ST2
7. 5A
GAUGE
2
2
I18
Ignition SW
2
11 1J
2
Engine Control System
< 6–8> < 6–11> < 6–14> < 6–15> < 6–16> < 6–17>
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
B–O
26 B
SP2+
S1
S2
11 B
10 B
12 C
9 E
SP2–
SR
9 B
IGSW
SLT+
13 B
8 B
11 C
STSW STAR/
NSW
SLT–
12 B
SLU+
15 B
33 D
34 D
CANH CANL
STA
SLU–
14 B
SL1+
19 B
SL1–
18 B
23 E
18 E
TC
SL2+
17 B
19 E
VPA
26 E
VPA2
SL2–
16 B
27 E
20 E
VCPA VCP2
THO1
24 B
EPA
THO2
32 B
21 E
EPA2
E2
28 A
8 D
15 E
SPD
23 A
STP
E03
4 B
VC
E04
7 B
20 A
E05
6 B
9
BR
R
L
Y
V
OT+
OT2+
L
O
W–B
B
11 IC4
B
L
O
OT–
2
OT2–
1
BR
BR
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
Front Left
Fender
VTA2
ME01
3 B
Rear Side of
Left Bank
Cylinder Block
EF
W–B
W–B
SL2–
W–B
SL2+
LG
SB
SL1–
GR
B
SL1+
G
W
SLU–
W–B
10
SLU+
BR
3
SLT–
L
11
Y–G
4
B–R
12
B–W
5
B–Y
13
G–B
6
SLT+
Battery
EB
19 A
VTA1
B
SR
R–W
14
S2
R–B
7
S1
L–R
15
LG–B
8
P–L
A B
W–L
C A
2
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
B
A
B A
L–Y
34 B
NT–
GR
A B
+B2
2 E
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
B B
R–L
27 B
NT+
B–O
B
B
1
Y–R
35 B
B
A
B B
W–R
1 E
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
V11
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically
Controlled Transmission)
T4
Turbine Speed Sensor
GR
W–B
1
B
1
1
20A EFI
Short Pin
30A AM2
10A ETCS
2
+BM
B–O
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
+B
2
7 E
BATT
2
2
2
2
1
13 IC4
3 E
MREL
L
GR
R
B
W
2
2
8 E
2
2
2
GR
3
2
12 IC4
L
EFI
Relay
2
2
35 IC4
1
W–G
1
1
2
L
140A ALT
2
5
1
W–G
L
W–G
2
10A DOME
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
50A AM1
R–L
2
1
2
4 1G
A
B
C
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
456
(Cont. next page)
14 4RUNNER
14 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
(Cont. next page)
E le c tro n ic a lly C o n tro lle d T ra n s m is s io n a n d A /T In d ic a to r (1 G R – F E )
A
B
C
5
R
∗ 1 : w/ Navigation System
8
7
6
R
A
L–Y
R–L
R–L
Y–R
2 1C
A
A
A
Y–R
Y–R
J7
Junction
Connector
H
A
2
IM1
Y–R
Y–R
J25
Junction
Connector
H
P1
Park/Neutral Position SW
2
15A IG1
RB
J20
Junction
Connector
LL
2L
DL
NL
RL
PL
8
3
7
9
1
6
ATD
10
5
2
E B
F B
H A
A A
E B
A A
C A
C A
C B
V
L
L
C B
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction Connector
A A
B A
R–Y
B A
G–W
W
W–B
G
L
A
P–L
J37
Junction
Connector
IK
B–L
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
EE
P
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
M
457
Right Kick
Panel
D
R–Y
4WD Control ECU
< 19–3>
A B
B A
G–W
W
P–L
G
B–L
V
R–Y
P
BR
BR
BR
W–B
L
C
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction Connector
19 D
AT2
H A
G–B
R–Y
(∗1)
21 D
NSSL
H A
R–Y
11 D
NSSD
G–W
3
AT4
8 IM1
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
D
B B
ATL
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction Connector
29 D
R
G B
D A
G–W
OILW
F A
V
2
V
10 D
4
L
1 C
20 D
L
3
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
6 A
E1
9 D
L
Radio and Player
with Display< 28–9>
G–R
E02
I A
S6
Transmission Control SW
7 A
THA
G–W
V
E01
22 A
G
E2G
1 IM1
D B
9
4
G–R
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
EOM
35 D
29 A
B–L
VG
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
30 A
G
THW
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
GE01
10 IM1
V
A B
D B
9 IM1
G 3C D 3C D 3E
D 3C
B–L
21 A
17 A
M–
D
3E
E A
G–R
4 A
G–R
B B
G
M+
E A
21 IM2
D 3C
G 3C
B–L
5 A
B A
G–R
D A
G
B–L
Engine Control System
< 6–11> < 6–12>
J35(A), J36(B)
Junction
Connector
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Y–R
20 IM2
G–B
R–Y
G–W
V
L
G–R
8 1J
G 3C
B
E le c tro n ic a lly C o n tro lle d T ra n s m is s io n a n d A /T In d ic a to r (1 G R – F E )
A
R
∗ 2 : w/ Driving Position Memory
12
11
10
R
B
9
R–L
D
J7
Junction
Connector
D
R
F B
G–B
C 8(A), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
E A
C A
G–B
(∗2)
Position Control
ECU and SW
< 33–2>
J18(A), J19(B)
Junction
Connector
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
< 15–3>
C B
G–B
C A
G–B
C A
P
R
N
D
4
3
2
L
A/T OIL TEMP
A B
R–Y
G–B
D
16 C
G–B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction Connector
E A
15 C
R
R–L
C
C A
G–B
20 D
1 C
19 D
18 D
17 D
16 D
15 D
14 D
15 A
2 1L
2 1J
13 C
BR
P
B–L
P–L
L
G
7 IM1
W
G
L
BR
K
W
I
J
G–W
H
R–Y
F
G
G–W
G–B
R–Y
E
Body ECU
< 7–39>
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C A
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
H A
J35(A)
Junction
Connector
P–L
B–L
P
EE
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
458
14 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
459
P o w e r S o u rc e
A B S , T R A C , V S C , A u to L S D , D o w n h ill A s s is t C o n tro l a n d H ill– S ta rt A s s is t C o n tro l
1
4
3
2
W
L–Y
ACC
2 AM1
B–R
IG1 4
B
C
L–Y
4WD Control
ECU< 19–6>
4WD Control
ECU< 19–2>
5 IC2
2 IC2
G–R
(4WD)
11 IM2
R–L
(4WD)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
13 IC2
W–L
(4WD)
R–W
G–B
P
L
R
G
Stop Light SW
< 11–2>
I18
Ignition SW
Data Link
Connector 3
< 5–6> < 5–7> < 6–6>
R–L
(4WD)
2
Transfer
Shift
Actuator
< 19–4>
1
Parking Brake SW
< 7–38>
2
Park/Neutral
Position SW
< 13–12> < 14–9>
ST2
1
STOP LP CTRL Relay
< 11–2> < 11–3>
B–R
A10
ABS Speed Sensor
Front RH
IG2 6
A9
ABS Speed Sensor
Front LH
7 AM2
A
12 IC2
1 IC2
STPO
14 A
45 A
7 A
28 A
P
STP2
STP
13 A
PKB
D/G
24 A
TS
42 A
21 A
27 A
EXI
WFSE
G–R
(4WD)
16 A
FR–
W–L
(4WD)
17 A
FR+
R–L
(4WD)
3 A
FL–
R–W
4 A
FL+
R–B
18 A
+BS
R–Y
31 A
LG
+BM2
G–B
2 B
G–Y
LG
+BM1
G–B
Y
Y–B
Y–B
Y–B
Y
R
W
W–L
2 A
10 A
EXI4
NEO
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
2
2
2
2
2
LBL
EXI3
41 A
2
26 A
GND1
GND3
1 A
4 B
RL+
GND2
20 A
32 A
W–G
(4WD)
17 IC2
W–G
(4WD)
W
W–B
(4WD)
B 3F
B 3F
W–B
Front Right
Fender
BO
Rear Pillar LH
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
II
A
IK
A
J37
Junction
Connector
EA
W–B
W–B
1
J24
Junction
Connector
W–B
Front Left
Fender
B 3F
B 3F
2
A
EB
D5
Downhill Assist
Control SW
3 BE1
4
B
W
4 BE1
W
1
B
W–B
(∗4)
2
2 BC2
3 BC2
A41
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear RH
W–B
(∗4)
B
W–B
: Shielded
: 1GR–FE 4WD
: w/ Electric Modulated Air Suspension
: w/o Electric Modulated Air Suspension
ADD Actuator
< 19–3>
1
2
3
4
A40
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear LH
B
∗
∗
∗
∗
8 IB2
(∗1)
6 BC2
(∗4)
1 BE1
B
Battery
(∗1)
2 BE1
W
W–B
W–B
W–B
2
1 BC2
(∗4)
B B
1
5 BC2
V(∗3)
G(∗4)
A A
4 BC2
P(∗3)
R(∗4)
A A
44 A
3
B A
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
18 IC3
GR
(∗2)
2
1
W–B
2
1
A B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
1
40A ABS MTR
30A ABS SOL
30A AM2
Short Pin
140A ALT
1
1
2
HDCS
RR–
19 A
W
2
7 IB2
B
2
B14
Brake Fluid Level
Warning SW
2
10 IB2
V
P
2
2
B
9 IB2
RR+
5 A
V
P
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
(2UZ–FE)
GR
(∗2)
LG
50A AM1
1
RL–
6 A
Right Kick
Panel
D
E
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
460
(Cont. next page)
15 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
15 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
A B S , T R A C , V S C , A u to L S D , D o w n h ill A s s is t C o n tro l a n d H ill– S ta rt A s s is t C o n tro l
A
B
C
5
W
8
7
6
B–R
L–Y
10A ECU–B
2
2
R
R
J7
Junction
Connector
D
HDCW
R
33 A
17 C
20 C
4 D
19 A
4 B
13 C
16 C
R
BR
GR–R
B–L
R
L–W
(∗5)
L–W
(2UZ–FE)
L–W
(∗2)
LG–R
F B
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
18 C
Y–R
BR–Y
(4WD)
Y–R
13 IM2
7 IC3
12 A
BR–Y
(4WD)
20 IC2
BR–Y
(4WD)
Y–R
R
LG–R
B–L
14 IM2
D
L–W
(∗2)
L–W
(∗7)
L–W
(∗6)
L–W
(∗5)
12 IM2
7 IM1
W–B
W–B
BR
(2UZ–FE)
BR
(1GR–FE)
A B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B
A
IG
W–B
W–B
E
A
B
10 IC4
H A
9 IC2
G–W
(∗7)
V–W
(∗6)
19 IC2
Speedometer
L–W
(4WD)
16 IC2
BRAKE
VSCW
36 A
ABS
WT
35 A
Slip
15 A
V–W
(2WD)
18 IC2
INFR
IND
34 A
R
8 IC2
WA
29 A
LG–R
7 IC2
BRL
3 B
B–L
B
W
W–B
(2WD)
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
A B
11 IC2
GR–R
R–W
(2WD)
4
22 IC2
SP1
12 A
GR–R
A42
Auto LSD SW
6 IC2
B
W
R–W
(2WD)
3
CANH
11 A
VSC OFF (4WD)
AUTO LSD (2WD)
IG1
VSC TRAC
46 A
BZ
DAC
25 A
15 C
2
B–R
CANL
CSW
2
W–R
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
43 A
1
10A DOME
B–R
IG2
1
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
B–R
GR–G
30 A
1 B
FRO
: 1GR–FE 4WD
: w/ Electric Modulated Air Suspension
: 1GR–FE 2WD
: 2UZ–FE 2WD
: 2UZ–FE 4WD
12 1E
V5
VSC Warning Buzzer
37 A
FLO
J4
Junction
Connector
B–O
38 A
1
B–R
B–R
B–O
L–R
(∗3)
L–O
(∗3)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C
C
F
F
2
10A ECU–IG
F
2
3
5
6
7
R–L
7. 5A GAUGE
10A IGN
J4
Junction Connector
∗
∗
∗
∗
∗
28 1J
2 1C
4 1G
2
B–R
L–Y
R–L
B–R
Suspension
Control ECU< 18–5>
6 1D
23 1E
D
A
B–R
W
C
D
E
F
J5
Junction
Connector
Rear Side of Right
Bank Cylinder Block
EE
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
M
461
Left Kick
Panel
A B S , T R A C , V S C , A u to L S D , D o w n h ill A s s is t C o n tro l
a n d H ill– S ta rt A s s is t C o n tro l
9
A
12
11
10
B–R
B–R
W–R
4 1B
B
M u ltip le x C o m m u n ic a tio n S y s te m (C A N )
G
J20
Junction
Connector
W–R
E7
Engine Control
Module
B–R
W–R
D A
B 3E
B 3E
E B
D A
CANH
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
6
LG
2 B
1 D
2 D
1 E
2 E
ST–Plug
1 C
2 C
1 A
2 A
1 F
W
B
Y
B
W–B
B
Y
W–B
J47(A), J48(B), J49(C), J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction Connector
1 B
GND
1
3
3
CANL
34
L
P
CANH
CANH
CANH
33
R
11
CANL
2
IG
W
CANL
2
W
ESS
5
R
IG1
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
1
BAT
B–R
B–R
W–R
S11
Steering Sensor
9
CANL
14
V
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
G
4 1L
W–B
C
D
E
F
W–B
W–B
B
W
IH
Instrument Panel
Brace LH
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
462
15 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
463
C ru is e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
B–R
6 1D
7 AM2
IG2 6
R–L
B–R
ST2
15 C
7. 5A
GAUGE
10A
IGN
I18
Ignition SW
B–O
3
2
3 E
7 E
BATT
+BM
16 E
18 D
9 E
ST1–
IGSW
PI
CCS
+B2
2 E
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
2 D
L–B
2
B
B
10A
ETCS
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
1 E
20A
EFI
3 IK1
B A
A B
A B
Junction
Connector
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
L–B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
1
B B
2
11 A
LG
+B
W–B
B
2
2
1
B B
L
GR
2
1
J8
Junction
Connector
B–O
8 E
2
MREL
30A
AM2
B–O
B–O
R–L
2
2
2
GR
L
W–G
3
CRUISE
11 IC3
Stop Light
System< 11–2>
1
EFI
Relay
2
C
13 IC4
B A
B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
12 IC4
J4
Junction Connector
35 IC4
R–L
B
C
R–L
5
2
B–O
1
4 1G
11 1J
B–O
4
23 1E
GR
2
R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–G
S12
Stop Light SW
L
5
CCS
C A
ON–OFF
B
B
+ RES
BR
W–B
11 IC4
– SET
C13
Combination
SW
10 IM2
B
Battery
CANCEL
BR
ECC
EB
Front Left
Fender
4
BR
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
464
(Cont. next page)
16 4RUNNER
16 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
C ru is e C o n tro l (2 U Z – F E )
5
8
7
6
E05
6 B
E01
7 A
E02
6 A
E03
4 B
E1
1 C
4WD
8 C
E04
7 B
28 A
23 E
E2
TC
33 D
34 D
CANH CANL
23 A
20 A
VC
VTA1
19 A
5 A
VTA2
M+
4 A
M–
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
S1
S2
ME01
EOM
35 D
3 B
11 B 10 B
EC
9 C
17 A
GE01
SR
9 B
18 E
VPA
SLT+
13 B
19 E
VPA2
SLT–
12 B
26 E
27 E
VCPA VCP2
SLU+
15 B
SLU–
14 B
20 E
EPA
SL1+
19 B
21 E
8 D
EPA2
SPD
SL1–
18 B
SL2+
17 B
15 E
STP
SL2–
16 B
D
21 D
W–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control System
< 5–8> < 5–11> < 5–12> < 5–13> < 5–16> < 5–17> < 5–18>
BR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
1 IM2
W–B
Electronically Controlled Transmission and
A/T Indicator System< 13–2> < 13–3> < 13–4> < 13–7>
A B
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
A A
W–B
W–B
A
J37
Junction
Connector
EE
EE
Rear Side of
Cylinder Block
IK
Right Kick
Panel
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
M
465
Rear Side of
Cylinder Block
C ru is e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
B–R
6 1D
7 AM2
IG2 6
R–L
B–R
ST2
15 C
7. 5A
GAUGE
10A
IGN
I18
Ignition SW
B–O
3
2
1 E
3 E
7 E
BATT
+BM
16 E
18 D
9 E
ST1–
IGSW
PI
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
1 C
L–B
20A
EFI
B A
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
5
J28
Junction
Connector
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
BR
3 IK1
A B
L–B
1
2 D
B
B
10A
ETCS
E1
CCS
+B2
2 E
2
A B
CCS
2
11 A
LG
+B
W–B
B
2
2
1
B B
L
GR
2
1
J8
Junction
Connector
B–O
8 E
2
MREL
30A
AM2
B–O
B–O
R–L
2
2
2
GR
L
W–G
3
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
11 IC3
Stop Light
System< 11–2>
1
EFI
Relay
2
C
13 IC4
B A
B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
12 IC4
J4
Junction Connector
35 IC4
CRUISE
C
R–L
5
2
R–L
B
GR
2
4 1G
11 1J
B–O
1
23 1E
B–O
4
R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
W–G
S12
Stop Light SW
L
B B
C A
E
BR
B
B
ON–OFF
E
+ RES
BR
W–B
C13
Combination SW
11 IC4
– SET
10 IM2
BR
BR
B
Battery
CANCEL
ECC
EB
Front Left
Fender
4
BR
EE
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
466
(Cont. next page)
17 4RUNNER
17 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
C ru is e C o n tro l (1 G R – F E )
5
8
7
6
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control System
< 6–8> < 6–11> < 6–12> < 6–15> < 6–16> < 6–17>
E01
7 A
E02
E03
4 B
6 A
28 A
23 E
E2
TC
E04
7 B
E05
6 B
33 D
34 D
CANH CANL
23 A
VC
20 A
19 A
VTA1
5 A
VTA2
M+
E 4(A), E 5(B), E 6(C), E 7(D), E 8(E)
Engine Control Module
ME01
EOM
3 B
35 D
4 A
17 A
M–
18 E
GE01
S1
S2
11 B
10 B
19 E
VPA
SR
9 B
26 E
VPA2
SLT+
13 B
27 E
20 E
VCPA VCP2
SLT–
12 B
SLU+
15 B
21 E
EPA
SLU–
14 B
8 D
EPA2
SL1+
19 B
15 E
SPD
STP
SL1–
18 B
SL2+
17 B
SL2–
16 B
D
21 D
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
BR
BR
Electronically Controlled Transmission
and A/T Indicator System< 14–2> < 14–3> < 14–6>
A A
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction Connector
A B
W–B
A
J37
Junction
Connector
EE
EF
Rear Side of
Left Bank
Cylinder Block
IK
Right Kick
Panel
M
467
Rear Side of
Right Bank
Cylinder Block
P o w e r S o u rc e
A c tiv e H e ig h t C o n tro l S u s p e n s io n a n d E le c tric M o d u la te d A ir S u s p e n s io n
1
4
3
2
R
B–R
B–R
R
ACC
2 AM1
L–Y
IG1 4
L–Y
2 1C
D
J7
Junction
Connector
7 AM2
10A
ECU–IG
IG2 6
ST2
R
R
Data Link
Connector 3
< 5–7>
D
H15
Height Control Sensor Rear LH
SHB
W–L
G–R
W
GR
19 BC2
SHRL
21 A
20 A
SGL2
GR
23 A
SBL2
W
22 A
SIL
G–R
20 C
R–W
RM–
SLLO
26 A
SLRL
1 A
7 A
SLRR
SLEX
2 A
8 A
24 A
SBR2
19 A
SHRR
SGR2
V
LG
13 BC2
15 BC2
9 IC5
H19
Height Control Mode Select SW
E
HEIGHT
CONTROL
OFF
W–B
6
4
W–B
W–B
1 BC1
3
LOSW
GND
2
G
5
HSW
H12
Height Control SW
H13
Height Control Compressor
W–B
+
11 IC5
L–W
L
3
1
2
10 IC5
LG
3
H17
Height Control Valve
W–B
W–B
L–B
L1
Low Pressure Tank Valve
2
1
V
1
2
H14
Height Control Motor
1
V–W
P–G
P
4
TD
24 B
G
V–W
14 BC2
DNSW
15 B
L–W
P–G
12 BC2
UPSW
16 B
L
P
21 BC2
O
B B
18 BC2
O
B
B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
2
9 BC2
20 BC2
GR
30A AM2
Short Pin
2
R–W
RM+
25 A
3
B A
3
11 BC2
GR–G
B
1
1
SHG
2
GR–G
TS
1 IB1
140A ALT
2
2
GR
1
5 C
TC
SHRR
S13(A), S14(B), S15(C)
Suspension Control ECU
6 B
2
6 C
IG
2
2
1
4
L–B
1
4
W–B
2
3
2
50A AIR SUS
50A AM1
R
W
2
2
2
10 C
1
17 BC2
BR–W
2
RC
SHB
3
R–Y
2
18 A
SHG
22 BC2
P–L
2
1
B–R
2
5
2
10A
AIRSUS NO. 2
1
4
AIR SUS Relay
1
L–Y
10A DOME
4
5 IC5
F
BR–Y
2
J4
Junction
Connector
R–B
L–Y
L–Y
L–Y
BR–Y
5 IB2
P–L
BR–Y
R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
F
2
BR–W
B–R
10 IC4
I18
Ignition SW
SHRL
1
12 1E
H16
Height Control Sensor Rear RH
Battery
L–B
W–B
W–B
A
EB
Front Left
Fender
BN
J24
Junction
Connector
A
Near the No. 5
Crossmember of
Side Frame LH
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
II
A
B
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
468
(Cont. next page)
18 4RUNNER
18 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
A c tiv e H e ig h t C o n tro l S u s p e n s io n a n d E le c tric M o d u la te d A ir S u s p e n s io n
A
B
5
R
8
7
6
B–R
B–R
R
6 1D
15 C
L–R
L–O
R–G
B–W
G–B
13 B
8 C
9 C
FLO
4 C
FRO
DOOR
VN
15 C
LO
18 C
BR–B
3 IC5
4 A
3 A
2 A
5 A
13 C
BR
Y–G
Y
Y–B
BR–B
BR–B
7 IM1
BR
W–B
EB
2 IC5
Y–B
A A
NR
17 C
Y–B
A B
1 IC5
Y
Y–G
A A
A B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
Y
Y–G
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
4 IC5
HI
16 C
OFF
GND2
5 B
HI
MOD1
12 C
N
LO
GND
1 C
Height Control
TACH
S13(A), S14(B), S15(C)
MOD2
16 C
12 IC5
Suspension Control ECU
11 C
R
R–L
R–G
B–W
Stop Light SW
< 11–2>
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
STP
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
Body ECU
< 7–29>
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
< 15–5>
Combination Meter
< 31–4>
F B
4 1G
13 IC5
12 B
H A
7. 5A
GAUGE
ED
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
M
469
Front Left
Fender
P o w e r S o u rc e
∗ 1 : 1GR–FE
∗ 2 : 2UZ–FE
M u lti M o d e 4 W D
1
4
3
2
B–R
A
ACC
W–B
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
10
GND
B–R
20A
4WD
ST2
M
I18
Ignition SW
13 1J
M
HM1
HM2
HL1
HL2
TM1
TM2
TL1
TL2
TL3
CDL
8
7
12
11
2
1
3
4
5
9
G–R
W–G(∗1)
BR–W
B
B
6 A
1 B
IG
4 B
HM1
HM2
17 B
26 B
HL1
2 B
HL2
5 B
TM1
25 B
TM2
24 B
TL1
23 B
TL2
22 B
TL3
20 A
P1
19 A
IND2
11 A
IND1
IND3
W–B
50A AM1
SPD
BR–W
9 A
G–R
R–L
2
Junction
Connector
W–G(∗1)
L–B
L–W
L–Y
(∗1)
L
G
GR
R–B
Y
L–R
V
V–R
2
2
G B
J28
B
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
F A
R–L
R–L
R
W–L
F 9(A), F10(B)
4WD Control ECU
GND
1
1 A
DL
L4
16 A
24 A
DM2
6 B
DL1
13 B
DL2
12 B
GR
(∗1)
C
R
(∗1)
B–W
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
P–L
(∗1)
1 EC1
2 EC1
3 EC1
4 EC1
C
W–B
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
6 EC1
5 EC1
3
1
2
6
5
4
ADD
DM1
DM2
DL1
DL2
GND
M
A11
ADD Actuator
II
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
ED : Left Bank Cylinder Head (∗2)
EF : Rear Side of Left Bank Cylinder Block (∗1)
W–B
W–B
(∗1)
P–L
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
B–W
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–2>
Left Kick
Panel
DM1
3 B
J24
Junction
Connector
Junction
Connector
IG
GR
(∗1)
A
GR
(∗1)
4
16 IM2
Engine Control Module
< 6–17>
GND
C
GR
(∗1)
J5
L4
W–B
A
Engine Control
Module< 5–17> < 6–17>
IK
A
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator< 15–4>
Right Kick
Panel
J37
Junction
Connector
A W–B
W–B
A
G–W
H4
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
A B
(∗1)
F11
4WD Control SW
(∗1)
Park/Neutral Position
SW< 13–11> < 14–8>
W–B
W–B
Battery
L
(∗1)
LO
H2
A A
J28
C
2
2–4
(∗1)
ADD
18 B
II1
6
L
(∗2)
W–L
B
4
F A
N
22 A
Junction
Connector
5
W–L
A A
F A
L
(∗2)
2
B
D4
Diff. Lock SW
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction Connector
2
P
(∗1)
GR
(∗2)
3
A B
2
H B
GR
(∗1)
1
1
II1
LO
15 A
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
30A AM2
6
2–4
8 A
W–L
GR
(∗1)
2
2
140A ALT
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Combination Meter
< 31–6>
W–B
6
GND
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
< 15–4>
IG2 6
W–B
7 AM2
W–B
T3
Transfer Shift Actuator
2 1C
B
C
D
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
470
(Cont. next page)
19 4RUNNER
19 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
M u lti M o d e 4 W D
5
A
C
D
∗ 1 : 1GR–FE
7
8
B–R
A
B
E
A
G–R
G–R
W–G(∗1)
G–R
B–R
B
6
E
A
BR–W
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
< 15–4>
G–R
4 1G
R–L
5 D
7. 5A
GAUGE
G–R
W–G
(∗1)
7 D
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction
Connector
H B
BR–W
15 C
6 D
4LO
4WD
Center Diff. Lock
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
E A
6 1D
C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
M
471
P o w e r S o u rc e
SRS
1
∗ 1 : w/ Side Airbag
4
3
2
W–R
ACC
W–R
W–L
2 AM1
IG1 4
B–O
L–Y
L–Y
R–L
7 AM2
R
2
2
IG2 6
B–R
S18
Side Airbag Sensor Rear LH
R–L
B–O
ST2
S19
Side Airbag Sensor Rear RH
C16
C17
Curtain Shield Airbag
Squib LH
Curtain Shield Airbag
Squib RH
2
50A AM1
I18
Ignition SW
6 1D
VUCL
4
CSR+
1
3
CSR–
VUCR
2
4
ESCR
1
1
2
1
2
Y–V
(∗1)
Y–O
(∗1)
Y–O
(∗1)
Y–V
(∗1)
GR–R
(∗1)
L–B
(∗1)
LG–B
(∗1)
L–W
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
8 D
7 D
R
B
W
2
2
1 A
15 A
5 C
CSL+
IG2
2
CSL–
14 A
VUCL
13 A
18 D
ESCL
CSR+
4 D
19 D
CSR–
VUCR
20 D
9 A
ESCR
10 A
ICR+
ICL–
ICL+
ICR–
A30(A), A31(B), A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
2
Airbag Sensor Assembly
E2
28 C
D–
13 C
D+
14 C
D2+
16 C
D2–
17 C
Y–O
E1
27 C
Y–V
30A AM2
Short Pin
1
ESCL
B–O
2
2
2
R
(∗1)
1
2
CSL–
3
L–Y
(∗1)
20 1L
CSL+
LG–B
(∗1)
140A ALT
1
7. 5A GAUGE
2
10A IGN
10A SRS
2
10A ECU–B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
4 1G
11 1J
P+
10 C
P–
11 C
P2+
8 C
P2–
7 C
+SL
15 C
–SL
26 C
+SR
9 C
–SR
20 C
1
BR–W
B–W
BR
W–R
Y–P
Y–GR
Y–G
Y–R
Y–B
Y
2
W–B
B
W–B
1 IU1
Instrument Panel
Brace LH
1 IN2
BR–W
IH
2 B
2 IN2
B–W
IJ
1 B
1 IC1
BR
Instrument Panel
Brace RH
2 A
2 IC1
W–R
A36
Airbag Squib
(Steering Wheel Pad)
1 A
4 IU1
Y–P
Battery
3
3 IU1
Y–GR
4
Spiral
Cable
Y–G
1
Y–R
2
2 IU1
2
1
2
1
+SL
–SL
+SR
–SR
A48(A), A49(B)
A14
A15
Airbag Squib
(Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
Airbag Sensor
Front RH
A
B
C
D
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
472
(Cont. next page)
20 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
20 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
∗ 1 : w/ Side Airbag
∗ 2 : w/o Side Airbag
SRS
5
A
B
C
D
8
7
6
W–R
W–R
B–O
B–O
L–Y
A
B
L–Y
R–L
R–L
S27
S26
Side Airbag
Squib LH
2
15A
IG1
SRS
P–AB
IG+
6
2
3 C
RMIL
SFR–
L–R
6 C
6 D
SFR+
P–L
5 D
SFL–
12 C
23 C
LA
H
A
R–Y
11 A
Y–R
Y–R
L–W
V
A
SIL
GSW2
19 C
2 C
TC
25 C
PBEW
1 C
PAON
Y–R
J25
Junction
Connector
L
B–Y
SFL+
J7
Junction
Connector
A
2 C
L–Y
(∗1)
12 A
Y–R
Combination Meter
< 7–34>
Data Link
Connector 3
< 5–7> < 6–7>
A
PAON
13
2 IL1
10 A
8 1J
D3
Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
L
Y–G
(∗1)
Y–R
(∗1)
Y–G
(∗1)
Y–R
(∗1)
H
J20
Junction
Connector
P–AB
A30(A), A31(B), A32(C), A33(D), A34(E)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
SSL+
17 A
SSL–
20 A
VUPL
16 A
ESL
18 A
SSR+
16 D
SSR–
13 D
VUPR
17 D
ESR
15 D
RMSW
21 C
PL+
8 A
PL–
7 A
PR+
9 D
2 B
1 B
5 E
PR–
10 D
6 E
LSP–
3 A
LSP+
4 A
LBE+
19 A
LBE–
2 A
FSR+
1 D
8 B
3 B
11 B
7 B
3 E
ESL
SSR+
SSR–
VUPR
ESR
A B
W–B
(∗1)
A
S16
Side Airbag Sensor Front LH
J5
Junction
Connector
S17
Side Airbag Sensor Front RH
Left Kick Panel
2
P16
P17
Pretensioner LH
Pretensioner RH
4 BI1
B
VUPL
1
B
W
SSL–
1
W
SSL+
4
G–R
2
2
10 E (∗2)
3
1 BI1
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
3
1
FSR–
2 D (∗1)
Y
1
Y–B
A A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
R25
Roll Sensing of Curtain
Shield Airbag Cutoff SW
W–B
(∗1)
4
1
W–B
(∗1)
4
2
Y
Y–B
B–R
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
P
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
L–Y
(∗1)
GR–L
(∗1)
P–L
(∗1)
LG–B
(∗1)
L–W
(∗1)
3
2
G–Y
4
1 IL1
3
G–W
R–B
B–R
(∗1)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Engine Control Module
< 5–17> < 6–17>
1
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
2
2 1C
15 C
RSCA OFF
1
Side Airbag
Squib RH
B
VS
W
GND
C
D
Buckle SW
B12
Buckle SW LH
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
IG
M
473
∗ 3 : w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
∗ 4 : w/o Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
SRS
9
A
B
12
11
10
W–R
B–O
4 1B
B
J8
Junction
Connector
B
W–R
B–O
B–O
14 IO3
SIG1
1
2
SGD1
3
O7
O8
Occupant Classification
Sensor Rear LH
Occupant Classification
Sensor Rear RH
SVC2
SIG2
1
2
SGD2
3
SVC3
SIG3
1
2
SGD3
3
SVC4
SIG4
1
2
SGD4
3
BR
B
V
W
Y
GR
O
L
W
G
BR
R
+B
FSR+
8 A
11 B
7 B
SVC1
SIG1
BSW
9 A
BGND
5 A
1 B (∗4)
B
12 B
SVC2
8 B
SIG2
2 B
SGD2
5 B
SVC3
DIA
2 A
2 BI1
9 B
SIG3
3 B
SGD3
6 B
SVC4
10 B
SIG4
4 B
SGD4
GND
O 3(A), O 4(B)
Occupant Classification ECU
3 A
W–B
1 A (∗3)
2 B
SGD1
3 BI1
R–Y
2 A
1 B
V
GR
L
W
B
16 IO3
W
W–B
R–Y
D
SVC1
O6
Occupant Classification
Sensor Front RH
R
BR
1 A
IG
FSR–
O5
Occupant Classification
Sensor Front LH
5 BI1
7 A
4 A
C
15 IO3
W–R
B–O
6 BI1
B 3E
W–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B B
B 3E
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
B A
4 1L
B16(A), (B)
Buckle SW RH
Data Link
Connector 3
< 5–8> < 6–8>
BM
Floor Seat
Crossmember RH
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
474
20 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
21 4RUNNER
P o w e r S o u rc e
F ro n t W ip e r a n d W a s h e r
1
4
3
2
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–Y
2 1C
I18
Ignition SW
W–L
30A
FR
WIP–WSH
2
22 1E
9 1J
L
L
50A
AM1
L
1
1
2
L–W
L–W
L–B
14
IC4
L–B
L–R
17
IC4
L–R
M
L
140A
ALT
16
IC4
2
L–Y
1
6 IN1
L–Y
2
3
1
4
8
+2
2
B
F7
Front Wiper Motor
Front Wiper and Washer SW
M
2
5
W2
Washer
Motor
2
B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
7
16
+1
+S
17
+B
11
F1
F2
WF
EW
OFF
INT
LO
HI
Washer
INT TIME
J15
Junction
Connector
A
Wiper Relay
W–B
Battery
C14
Combination SW
A
2
W–B
W–B
A
J5
Junction
Connector
EB
Left Kick
Panel
IG
M
475
Front Left
Fender
2 IO3
G–R
29 1J
32 1J
∗ 1 : w/ Power Seat (Front Passenger' s Seat)
R–L
LG
Rear
Front
Rear
Front
L3
Lumbar Support Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
Hold
W–B
W–B
W–B
(∗1)
W–B
BR
P
Y
L
Y
W
W
(∗1)
V
(∗1)
BR
(∗1)
P
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
A B
P25
Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger' s Seat
Reclining Control)
2
P26
Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger' s Seat
Slide Control)
2
L5
Lumbar Support
Control Motor
(Driver' s Seat)
2
P19
LG
Release
Down
Up
Rear
Front
Down
B
(∗1)
M
M
M
P21
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Lifter Control)
P23
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Reclining Control)
P20
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Front Vertical Control)
P24
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Slide Control)
B
B
(∗1)
P
(∗1)
V
(∗1)
L
P
A A
L
(∗1)
B
W–B
W–B
BM
Floor Seat
Crossmember RH
BL
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
2
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
1
1
1
A B
A B
A B
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
A A
2
2
1
1
Up
Y
(∗1)
L
(∗1)
2
4
2
8
7
2
M
M
M
M
2
Rear
2
4
1
3
6
9
Reclining
Slide
Lifter
Reclining
1
1
2
2
G–R
R–L
LG
(∗1)
Front
1
Junction
Connector
J45(A), J46(B)
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
30A D P/SEAT
L–W
1
3
5
2
50A
J/B
Power Seat Control SW
(Front Passenger' s Seat)
1
P18
Power Seat Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
2
3
5
10
6
9
Front
Vertical
Slide
140A
ALT
B B
B B
C A
C A
30A P P/SEAT
1 1C
2
4
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
P o w e r S e a t (D riv e r' s S e a t w /o D riv in g P o s itio n M e m o ry )
P o w e r S o u rc e
4
3
2
1
Pow er Seat
(F ro n t P a s s e n g e r' s S e a t)
G–R
24 IE1
B B
Battery
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
476
22 4RUNNER
23 4RUNNER
P o w e r S o u rc e
∗ 1 : w/ Driving Position Memory
∗ 2 : w/o Driving Position Memory
S e a t H e a te r
1
2
Y–R
4
3
J25
Junction
Connector
A
A
Y–R
ACC
W–B
A
3
Y–R
L–Y
W–B
IG1 4
Y–R
2 AM1
1
3
E
B–Y
2
2
2
2 1C
IG
S5
Seat Heater SW RH
W–L
S4
Seat Heater SW LH
IG
I18
Ignition SW
W–B
1
E
1
2
RV
2
1
20 1E
8 IO3
L
R
G A
H A
H A
G B
5
B 3F
B 3F
B 3F
1
LG
S25
Seat Heater RH
S24
Seat Heater LH
W–B
B
24 IC4
B 3F
R
BR
1
W–B
H B
G B
W–B
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
14 BK1
R
(∗1)
BR
(∗2)
BR
(∗1)
LG
Y–R
5
Y
(∗1)
H B
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction Connector
Y
R
(∗2)
(∗2)
H
V
(∗2)
Y–R
A
G A
13 BK1
Y–R
2
E
Y–R
2
Y–R
2
2
C
J20
Junction
Connector
J7
Junction
Connector
C
V
(∗1)
H
A
2
1
Y–R
Y–R
E
18 IO3
12 IE1
8 1J
Y–R
IG Relay
140A ALT
5
J1
Junction
Connector
SW
4
L
3
2
RV
2
R
V
13 IE1
2
1
SW
4
Y
50A AM1
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
15A
IG1
25A
SEAT
HEATER
F 3C
2
B
4
6
C B
J45(A), J46(B)
W–B
(∗2)
Junction
Connector
B A
1 BK1
BL
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
A
Floor Seat
Crossmember RH
BM
A
J24
Instrument
Panel Brace
RH
II
J37
Junction
Connector
Junction
Connector
Right
Kick
Panel
IK
M
477
Front Left
Fender
A A
W–B
W–B
(∗1)
LG
EB
A B
W–B
(∗1)
A A
LG
(∗2)
LG
(∗2)
LG
Battery
LG
(∗1)
B A
B
W–B
7 BK1
J53
Junction
Connector
W–B
10 IE1
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction Connector
W–B
9 IO3
LG
LG
B
B
A B
W–B
B
F 3C
C B
6
W–B
(∗1)
W–B
(∗2)
F 3C
B
(∗2)
B
(∗1)
J3
Junction
Connector
B
2
4
A u to m a tic
G la re – R e s is ta n t E C
M irro r w ith C o m p a s s
P o w e r S o u rc e
M oon R oof
1
IG1 4
4
3
2
ACC 3
2 AM1
R e m o te C o n tro l M irro r
J6
Junction
Connector
C
C
GR
W–G
GR
L–Y
W–G
L–W
17 IA1
2 1C
L–W
W–L
L–W
I18
Ignition SW
5 1D
1 1C
R24
Remote Control Mirror SW
Operation SW
Select SW
W–B
W–B
16 IA1
4 IA2
Y–B
2
16 IP1
15 IP1
17 IP1
2
3
1
3
2
1
MH
MV
M+
MV
MH
M+
M
M
M3
Remote Control
Mirror LH
M
M
M4
Remote Control
Mirror RH
W–B
L–R
G–R
L–Y
Y–B
Left Kick
Panel
Engine Control
System< 5–3> < 6–3>
W–B
J5
Junction
Connector
P–B
P–G
B
IG
B
J38
Junction
Connector
13 1A
Battery
A
C
L–R
4
W–B
2 1H
Y–B
2
2
2
B
LG–R
P7
Moon Roof Control SW
2
14 IA1
LG–B
15 1A
Right
/Down
GR
3
ACC CUT Relay
1
E
6 1A
14 1A
C
2
15 IA1
SLIDE
W–B
2
30 IC4
P
W–B
2
3
UP
7
C
6
4
E
6
G–R
7
M+
3
L–Y
8
W–B
6
1
38 IC4
LG
I19
Inner
Mirror
4
F 3E
OPEN
GR
B
E
CLOSE
Left
/Up
SPD
2
L–Y
IG
E
VR
GR
E2
RH
VL
P–B
PWS
M–
7
LH
HR
P–G
5
P
2
+B
4
M5
Moon Roof Control ECU
M
RH
HL
G–R
Y
IG
1
LH
5
10
M+
F 3E
V
9
L
L–O
140A
ALT
8 1K
11 1A
B–R
2
Down
3 1A
Up
2 1A
Right
2
P
1
Body ECU
< 7–6>
50A AM1
50A J/B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
10A
ECU–IG
B
Left
15A
IG1
2
Combination Meter
< 31–5>
2
8
7. 5A ACC
1
2
30A POWER
2
A
IG
J5
Junction
Connector
Left Kick
Panel
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
478
24 4RUNNER
25 4RUNNER
C ig a re tte
L ig h te r
P o w e r O u tle t (1 1 5 V )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
P o w e r O u tle t (1 2 V )
4
3
2
L–W
V
IG1 4
W–G
W–G
L–W
ACC 3
2 AM1
L–Y
5 1D
1 1C
2 1C
W–L
V
L–W
I18
Ignition SW
10A
CIG
15A
IG1
2
V
Y–R
Y–R
Y–R
E
C
2
2
5
1
B
16 IE1
4
14 IE1
1
W–B
1
A A
B 3F
A B
A B
A
J24
Junction
Connector
W–B
II
Instrument
Panel Brace
RH
Floor Seat
Crossmember
LH
BL
Rear
Pillar
LH
BO
M
479
Left Kick
Panel
W–B
A
A
IG
W–B
W–B
J5
Junction
Connector
Battery
A A
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
4
B 3F
W–B
P5
Power Outlet
(115V)
B
A B
W–B
LG
A A
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
2 IS1
R–W
2
1
5 IR1
W–B
1 IS1
LG
R–W
V–R
L
W–B
Y–R
Y–R
21 IC4
41 IC4
15 IE1
2
P8
Power Outlet
(Rear)
IN
3
2
P6
Power Outlet
(Front)
1
W–B
E
2
W–B
LG
R–W
V–R
V
L
IG
27 IE1
BR–R
4
7
H
6
2
3
C6
Cigarette Lighter
1
GND
P–L
IG
V9
Voltage Inverter
AC1
AC2
BR–R
2
M2
Main SW
J20
Junction
Connector
2
31 1J
6 IR1
3
2
H
1
30 1J
17 1L
W–B
140A ALT
Y–R
Y–R
2 1H
BR–R
A
C
5
2
P–L
1
E
AC115V INV
Relay
A
J1
Junction
Connector
1
DC SKT
Relay
2
2
J7
Junction
Connector
1
2
50A AM1
15A AC115V INV
2
3
20 1E
2
Y–R
2
50A J/B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
1
8 1J
2
15A
PWR
OUTLET
7. 5A
ACC
P o w e r S o u rc e
H o rn
T ire P re s s u re W a rn in g S y s te m
1
E le c tric T e n s io n R e d u c e r
4
3
2
L–Y
ACC
IG1 4
2 AM1
W–L
B–R
2 1C
L–Y
6 1D
7 AM2
IG2 6
∗ 1 : w/ Driving Position Memory
∗ 2 : w/o Driving Position Memory
R
W–L
4 1G
I18
Ignition SW
28 1J
GND
IK
W–B
W–B
Floor Seat
Crossmember RH
BM
A B
1 BK1
A A
W–B
(∗1)
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
W–B
(∗2)
A
1
IO3
W–B
J37
Junction
Connector
Right Kick
Panel
A A
A
B
4
BL
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
RDA
W–B
(∗1)
W–B
(∗2)
+5V
T17
Tire Pressure
Warning Antenna and Receiver
G
(∗2)
4
W–B
1
A B
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
L
Battery
Theft Deterrent ECU
< 7–16>
Horn SW
B
5
J43(A), J44(B)
Junction
Connector
6
C13
Combination
SW
V
(∗2)
LG–B
J53
Junction
Connector
B
W–B
(∗1)
LG–B
GR
A A
4
W–B
GR
1 BD1
L
11 BD1
G–R
G–R
12 BD1
Y–R
A B
B B
2
5
5
33 IE1
B15
Buckle SW LH
32 IE1
B17
Buckle SW RH
30 IE1
J33(A), J34(B)
Junction
Connector
H10
Horn
(Low)
11
W–B
H9
Horn
(High)
Y–R
16
I B
G
(∗1)
7
F A
12 BK1
G
8
1
I B
GND
V
(∗1)
IG
J45(A), J46(B)
Junction
Connector
GND2
2
F A
2
SIL
1
V
RDA
GR
1
B B
4
LG–B
C A
RF5V
L
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
1
C A
TC
B–R
GR–B
10A
HORN
12
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
2
2
1
GR–B
2
G–R
2
30A
AM2
G–R
(Except Limited)
W–G
R
2
R–Y
V–R
SPD
P–L
P–B
3
IND
5 IE1
2
A 3D
6
Junction
Connector
T12
Tension Reducer
Solenoid LH
A 3D
J7
A
A
1
1 A
2
Y–R
Y–R
1 1D
H
J20
Junction
Connector
Y–R
13 1K
H
T13
Tension Reducer
Solenoid RH
3
D
A
Y–R
7 IO3
B–R
1
2
D
J12
Junction
Connector
Body ECU
< 7–16>
140A
ALT
A
B–R
Data Link Connector 3
< 5–7> < 5–8> < 6–7> < 6–8>
HORN
Relay
Combination Meter
< 31–6>
5
2
C 8(A), C10(C)
Combination Meter
1
Tire Pressure
1
J20
Junction
Connector
W–G
G
10 1E
Y–R
G
15 C
50A
AM1
B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
8 1J
J25
Junction
Connector
A
B–R
R–L
2
15A
IG1
10A
ECU–IG
7. 5A
GAUGE
B–R
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
480
26 4RUNNER
27 4RUNNER
P o w e r S o u rc e
T ra ile r T o w in g
1
5
5
STTR
TAIL
BRK
BATT
GND
1
7
2
6
B
W–B
L
EB
IG
Rear Pillar
LH
BO
A A
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
BL
M
481
Left Kick
Panel
A B
W–B
J5
A B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
1 BF1
J40(A), J41(B)
Junction
Connector
B B
Junction
Connector
Front Left
Fender
W
B
L
2 BG1
A B
G–Y
3
STTL
W–B
4
B/UP
G
B
Battery
3 BG1
G
Y
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
2
B A
2 BF1
18 IE1
A A
T15
Trailer Socket
Y
W–B
2
L–Y
1
3 BF1
4 BG1
BR
3
6
R
BRK
2
Y
GND
B–R
1
B
30A
TOWING
2 IB2
GND
RTOT
L–R
2
LTOT
1 BG1
STOP
8
STIN
T14
L–O
+B
Towing Brake
Controller
3
RTIN
Towing Converter Relay
4
T6
2
+B
R–Y
TAIL
1
4
1
G–B
2
Body ECU
< 7–5>
B
G
B–R
W–B
Y–R
5
L–B
3 IB2
9
LTIN
GR
Park/Neutral Position SW
< 12–3>
G–B
L
C
STOP LP CTRL Relay
< 11–3>
3
B
G–Y
E
25 IC4
J1
Junction
Connector
4 IB2
5
3
STOP LP CTRL Relay
< 11–3>
B
G
B
C
Turn Signal Flasher
Relay< 8–3> < 9–3>
TOWING
TAIL
Relay
2
J16
Junction
Connector
Y–R
1
3
3
GR
1
5 1L
E
2
3
3
3
20 1E
2
140A
ALT
5
3
2
10A TAIL
2
2
Taillight and Illumination
System< 10–1>
15A
IG1
Y–R
1
3
BATT
CHG
Relay
50A AM1
1
3
L
TAIL Relay
L–Y
W–L
2
30A BATT CHG
1
2
1
2 1C
2
2
50A J/B
40A TOWING
1
2
30A TOWING BRK
2
B–Y
L–W
B
L
2
2
3
GR
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
GR
B–Y
IG1 4
1
I18
Ignition SW
L
B
L–W
1 1C
ACC
2 AM1
4
3
2
N a v ig a tio n S y s te m , P a rk in g A s s is t (R e a r V ie w M o n ito r)
a n d A u d io S y s te m (w / N a v ig a tio n S y s te m )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
W–L
BR(∗2)
GR(∗2)
ACC 3
L–Y(∗2)
W–L
2 AM1
IG1
P
2
B
(∗1)
R
BR
1 BD2
B
W
R
(∗1)
3
19 IE1
25 IE1
23 IE1
L–Y
B
W
R
(∗1)
J6
Junction
Connector
1
T11
Television Camera
1 G
C
2
21 IE1
C
C
2 BD2
BR
4
B 3C
GR
(∗2)
GR
Engine Control
System< 5–3> < 6–3>
30 IC4
3 BD2
(∗1)
B 3C
R
W
B
GR
B 3C
W
10 BH1
(∗1)
BR
9 BH1
(∗1)
R
5 BH1
(∗1)
W
4 BH1
L–Y
(∗2)
L–Y
2
B
28 IC4
4 BD2
P
1
2
7. 5A
ACC
8 1K
20A RADIO NO. 2
50A AM1
1
2
F 3E
W
W–L
2
4
2
2
2
1
F 3E
D
L–Y
5 1D
2
2
3
38 IC4
P
1
W–L
23 B
B
V–
24 B
CA+
21 B
CGND
22 B
V+
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
ACC
11 G
MACC
GND
17 B
20 G
MIC+
19 B
MIC–
20 B
2
2
A 3B
MACC
3
1
MIC+
MIC–
(∗1)
A 3B
B 3A
4 IT1
BR
(∗3)
5
B
(∗1)
A 3B
B 3A
3 IT1
P
(∗3)
B 3A
2 IT1
L
(∗3)
2
W
(∗3)
2
GR
GR
2
1 IT1
P
(∗3)
1
L
(∗3)
W
(∗3)
BR
1
GR
Short Pin
140A ALT
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
20A RADIO NO. 1
2
B
C
2
ACC CUT Relay
W–G
L–Y
I18
Ignition SW
2
A
∗ 1 : Shielded
∗ 2 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
∗ 3 : w/ Telephone Microphone
B
BR
(∗3)
BR
GR
T18
Telephone Microphone
Battery
BR
(∗2)
IJ
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
GR
E
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
482
(Cont. next page)
28 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
28 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
N a v ig a tio n S y s te m , P a rk in g A s s is t (R e a r V ie w M o n ito r)
a n d A u d io S y s te m (w / N a v ig a tio n S y s te m )
A
B
C
D
5
W–L
∗ 1 : Shielded
∗ 2 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
8
7
6
W–L
A
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
BR(∗2)
GR(∗2)
L–Y(∗2)
GND6
ACC4
12
15
+B2
27
L–
14
SGN5
6
22
G
(∗2)
LG
(∗2)
20 ID1
4 ID1
G
(∗2)
(∗1)
1
AUXR
2
8
AUXL
CE
VV+
SW1
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
SWG
3
II1
1
II1
12
10
AU1
R
G
B
L
A37
1
2
ALO
ARO
ASGN
AUXO
Antenna
Amplifier
3
4
II1
SEEK+
Y–B
4 IV1
2
W–R
V–W
3 IV1
Y–B
W–R
V–W
2 IV1
8 E
L
(∗1)
G
R
B
B
1 IV1
SW2
6 E
7 E
Radio and Player with Display
1
+B
V14
Video Terminal
1 C
ADPG
6 C
9 BJ1
(∗1)
21 ID1
(∗1)
VV–
17 BJ1
LG
(∗2)
4 C
24
W
(∗2)
MUTE
OPEN
8
LG
(∗2)
VA–
5 C
6 F
TXM–
AUXL
16 BJ1
V
(∗2)
VAR+
2 C
10 F
7
W
(∗2)
TXM+
3
SGND
AUXR
V
(∗2)
9 F
CDL–
6
SGND
(∗2)
VAL+
3 C
5 F
(∗2)
CDL+
(∗2)
4 F
19 ID1
(∗1)
ANT
13 G
CDR–
18 BJ1
(∗1)
SGND
18 B
3 F
CDR+
(∗1)
TSW–
12 B
2 F
5
NTSC
SG7
23
22 ID1
R
(∗2)
CSLD
23 ID1
W
(∗2)
1 F
R
(∗2)
L
(∗2)
SLD
15 BJ1
G
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗1)
P
(∗2)
L
(∗2)
(∗2)
(∗1)
V
(∗2)
G
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
(∗1)
G
(∗2)
R
(∗2)
W
(∗2)
B
(∗2)
(∗2)
L–Y
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
BR
(∗2)
7
14 BJ1
GR
(∗2)
(∗2)
24 ID1
16 ID1
G
(∗2)
13 BJ1
(∗1)
17 ID1
(∗2)
21 BJ1
(∗1)
18 ID1
NTS4
W
(∗2)
5 ID1
SGN2
25
20 BJ1
GR
(∗2)
3 ID1
(∗2)
LG
(∗2)
W
(∗2)
2 ID1
19 BJ1
NTS1
11
P
(∗2)
8 BJ1
SG3
10
9
L
(∗2)
V
(∗2)
10 BJ1
SGN1
(∗2)
G
(∗2)
8 ID1
26
11 BJ1
LG
(∗2)
(∗1)
9 ID1
W
(∗2)
W
(∗2)
10 ID1
LMUT
TX–
13
L
(∗2)
G
(∗2)
5 BJ1
(∗1)
R
(∗2)
4 BJ1
11 ID1
TX+
31
3 BJ1
W
(∗2)
12 ID1
6 ID1
L+
30
2 BJ1
W
(∗2)
(∗2)
LG
(∗2)
LG
(∗2)
LG
(∗2)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
7 ID1
1 BJ1
R–
29
W
(∗2)
L–Y
(∗2)
7 BJ1
R+
28
B
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
6 BJ1
(∗2)
BR
(∗2)
24 BJ1
13 ID1
SG1
16
11
EAU
AU2
MODE
SEEK–
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
VOL+
VOL–
C13
Combination SW
GR
GR
B
M
483
E
N a v ig a tio n S y s te m , P a rk in g A s s is t (R e a r V ie w M o n ito r)
a n d A u d io S y s te m (w / N a v ig a tio n S y s te m )
A
9
W–L
∗ 1 : Shielded
12
11
10
D23
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 1
1
2
L
LG
4
3
Y
R
W
3 BB1
ATX–
15 G
MUTE
7 G
SLD
10 G
4 B
FR–
13 B
RL+
L+
L–
R+
R–
R–
R+
L–
L+
9 G
19 G
8 G
18 G
4 A
5 A
2 A
3 A
SLD
6 A
MUTE
1 A
TX–
7 A
TX+
8 A
ACC
12 A
FL+
FL–
6 B
WFR– WFL+
20 B
8 B
WFL–
19 B
GND2
15 B
GND
16 B
G–W
2
4
WF+
WF–
BR
BR
3
WF–
BR
L–R
B
G
R
(∗1)
W–R
W
B
1
WF+
35 IO2
38 IO2
3 IA2
1 IA2
L
R–L
GR
3
1
D22
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 1
BR
2
W4
Woofer
BR
V
P
1
S20
Door Speaker Front LH No. 2
2
GR
9 B
L–B
32 IO2
4
B
SPD
V
31 IO2
11 A
CTR–
V
29 IO2
12 B
CTR+
20 IO2
P
34 IO2
WFR+
17 B
P
18 IO2
RR–
GR
B
W
W–R
(∗1)
R
G
B
W
W
B
G
R
(∗1)
W–R
W
B
27 IO2
3 B
14 B
RR+
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
21 IO2
26 IO2
5 B
RL–
V–R
ATX+
G–B
18 B
FR+
R 9(D), R10(E), R11(F), R12(G), R26(B), R27(C)
Radio and Player with Display
5 G
G–B
7 B
+B2
25 IO2
G
10 B
+B
G
1 B
INT+
23 IO2
W
23 A
W
INT–
22 IO2
R
22 A
Y
IVO–
B
12 E
24 IO2
L
IVO+
16 IO2
10 IO2
LG
11 E
12 IO2
W–L
SLD1
L
P
13 E
W–L
P
REV
L
5 D
SPD
(∗1)
R–Y
V–R
LG
3 D
PKB
R
14 IO2
1 D
Y
B
B
1 BB1
L
B
3 BA1
3
8 IP2
LG
B
1 BA1
4
W
R
W–L
39 IO2
C5
Center Speaker
B
W–L
40 IO2
3 IP2
J42
Junction
Connector
R17
Rear Door
Speaker RH
1
2
Combination Meter
< 31–5>
1
36 IO2
P
L
(∗1)
Park/Neutral Position SW
< 13–11> < 14–8>
Combination Meter
< 31–6>
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Parking Brake SW
< 7–38>
2
S21
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 2
W–L
27 IC4
37 IO2
R16
Rear Door
Speaker LH
1
2
W–B
(w/ Side Airbag)
BM
Floor Seat
Crossmember RH
BP
Rear Pillar
RH
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
484
28 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
485
A u d io S y s te m (1 0 S p e a k e r)
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
4
3
2
W–L
GR
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
ACC 3
2 AM1
W–G
IG1
+B2
5 1D
16
8 BJ1
3 ID1
LG
(∗1)
2 ID1
8 ID1
W
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
9 ID1
10 BJ1
5 ID1
R
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
B 3A
ACC
11 A
BR
L–Y
4
GND
20 A
B 3A
GR
2
2
L–Y
3
ACC CUT Relay
1
B 3C
B
1 A
B 3A
GR
Short Pin
20A RADIO NO. 2
140A ALT
2
CDL–
R 1(A), R 4(B), R 5(C)
2
2
CDL+
Radio and Player
GR
B 3C
GR
GR
P
B 3C
L–Y
(∗1)
L–Y
2
1
A 3B
B
B
2
A 3B
2
Engine Control
System< 5–3> < 6–3>
BR
GR
Battery
V
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
5 B
G
(∗1)
B
(∗1)
4 B
CDR–
R
(∗1)
(∗1)
3 B
CDR+
(Shielded)
BR
(∗1)
2 B
GR
(∗1)
W
50A AM1
2
2
10 ID1
C
30 IC4
38 IC4
1
1
11 ID1
1 B
CSLD
J6
Junction
Connector
C
GR
2
1
12 ID1
11 BJ1
P
C
2
2
GR
(∗1)
L–Y
(∗1)
20A RADIO NO. 1
1
F 3E
2
2
13 ID1
(Shielded)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
P
L–Y
2
2
7 ID1
V
(∗1)
5 BJ1
G
(∗1)
4 BJ1
LMUT
26
L
(∗1)
3 BJ1
TX–
13
2
W–L
W–L
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
6 ID1
F 3E
14
(Shielded)
2 BJ1
8 1K
28 IC4
TX+
L–
31
G
(∗1)
1 BJ1
L+
30
R
(∗1)
24 BJ1
R–
29
W
(∗1)
6 BJ1
R+
28
B
(∗1)
BR
(∗1)
7 BJ1
SG1
27
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
27 IC4
7. 5A
ACC
GND6
12
L–Y
(∗1)
L–Y
W–L
I18
Ignition SW
ACC4
15
BR
(∗1)
IJ
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
9 B
TXM+
10 B
TXM–
6 B
MUTE
A
B
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
486
(Cont. next page)
29 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
29 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
A u d io S y s te m (1 0 S p e a k e r)
A
B
5
W–L
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
8
7
6
W–L
GR
GR
A
B
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
SGN2
NTS4
SGN5
25
6
22
AUXL
OPEN
8
24
7
16 BJ1
17 BJ1
G
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
18 BJ1
(Shielded)
V
(∗1)
15 BJ1
AUXR
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
14 BJ1
(Shielded)
G
(∗1)
(∗1)
13 BJ1
SG7
23
9 BJ1
LG
(∗1)
(Shielded)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
(∗1)
(Shielded)
W
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
(∗1)
32 IO2
35 IO2
R–
10 A
SLD
6 A
SLD
R 1(A), R 4(B), R 5(C)
Radio and Player
ALI
17 C
ARI
15 C
SW2
6 C
8 C
ANT
13 A
ATX+
5 A
3 A
L–
L+
TX–
7 A
TX+
8 A
GND2
15 B
GND
16 B
BR
27 IO2
BR
26 IO2
B
AU1
2 A
R+
W
II1
Y–B
10
12
MUTE
1 A
W–R
2
W–R
V–W
4 IV1
MUTE
7 A
W–R
II1
W
B
1
II1
ATX–
15 A
B
3
5 A
R–
Y–B
W–R
V–W
3 IV1
SWG
SW1
7 C
4 A
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
L
2 IV1
AUXI
19 C
(Shielded)
G
R
1 IV1
ASGN
16 C
R
18 A
R+
(Shielded)
8 A
L–
G
19 A
L+
B
9 A
W
V14
Video Terminal
34 IO2
(Shielded)
W
B
CE
G
8
R
2
AUXL
31 IO2
W
B
29 IO2
G
(∗1)
1
AUXR
(Shielded)
LG
(∗1)
3
SGND
4 ID1
20 ID1
V
(∗1)
6
SGND
G
R
21 ID1
(∗1)
5
NTSC
19 ID1
(Shielded)
SLD
22 ID1
R
(∗1)
7
23 ID1
G
(∗1)
(∗1)
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
24 ID1
18 IO2
11
EAU
AU2
L
B
G
R
1
+B
1
2
ALO
ARO
3
ASGN
4
SEEK+
MODE
A37
AUXO
SEEK–
Antenna
Amplifier
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
VOL+
W–B
(w/ Side Airbag)
VOL–
Floor Seat
Crossmember RH
BM
Rear Pillar
RH
BP
M
487
C13
Combination SW
A u d io S y s te m (1 0 S p e a k e r)
A
B
9
W–L
11
10
GR
W–L
GR
2
Y
R
W
W–L
3 BA1
1 BB1
3 BB1
WF+
WF–
WF+
WF–
2
4
1
3
L–R
L–B
BR
24 IO2
16 IO2
G–W
W
R
Y
B
J42
Junction
Connector
14 IO2
22 IO2
V–R
5 B
13 B
RL+
W
4 B
+B2
R
+B
Y
10 B
1 B
ACC
B
12 A
W–L
W–L
GR
RL–
8 B
14 B
RR+
RR–
WFL+
19 B
WFL–
9 B
20 B
WFR+
WFR–
11 A
SPD
S22(A), S23(B)
Stereo Component Amplifier
FL+
FL–
6 B
FR+
17 B
FR–
7 B
CTR+
3 B
18 B
CTR–
DRS+
12 B
DRS–
2 B
11 B
BR
G–W
G–B
G
L
LG
V
P
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
B
1
2
1 BA1
B
B
1
W4
Woofer
B
36 IO2
R17
Rear Door
Speaker RH
Combination Meter
< 31–5>
38 IO2
R16
Rear Door
Speaker LH
C
21 IO2
20 IO2
12 IO2
23 IO2
10 IO2
D
C
25 IO2
D
1 IA2
3 IP2
8 IP2
4
11 IO3
D22
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 1
4
3
L
2
LG
V
P
1
1
22 IE1
Rear Speaker RH
BR
2
R20
20 IE1
G–W
1
S21
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 2
S20
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 2
2
10 IO3
BR
3
3
G–W
4
G–B
3
G
W
R
L
R–L
4
D
BR
G–W
3 IA2
BR
G–W
L
LG
V
P
C
J42
Junction
Connector
4
1
3
2
D23
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 1
C5
Center Speaker
R19
Rear Speaker LH
12
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
488
29 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
489
A u d io S y s te m (6 S p e a k e r)
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
L–Y
P
2 AM1
ACC 3
W–G
IG1 4
L–Y
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
ACC4
10 BJ1
8 BJ1
(Shielded)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
11 ID1
V
(∗1)
12 ID1
11 BJ1
W
(∗1)
5 BJ1
LMUT
26
G
(∗1)
4 BJ1
LG
(∗1)
3 BJ1
TX–
13
L
(∗1)
2 BJ1
(Shielded)
1 BJ1
LG
(∗1)
P
6 ID1
10 ID1
9 ID1
2 ID1
8 ID1
3 ID1
5 ID1
L–Y
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
5 C
V
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
4 C
CDR–
G
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
3 C
CDR+
R
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
2 C
(Shielded)
B
(∗1)
GR
4
L–Y
(∗1)
2
F 3E
B 3A
B 3C
L–Y
3
GR
1
ACC CUT Relay
P
P
F 3E
14
2
2
B 3C
20A RADIO NO. 1
1
2
TX+
L–
31
GR
(∗1)
L–Y
2
30
B 3A
B 3C
7 ID1
W–L
2
2
F 3E
2
2
4 A
3 A
+B
W
1 C
ACC
CSLD
CDL+
9 C
CDL–
TXM+
GR
50A AM1
2
FL+
1
38 IC4
R
W
1 BB1
3 BB1
Y
R
2
1
W
D22
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 1
3 BA1
L
2
1 BA1
B
3
LG
V
P
1
RR–
3 B
Y
B
Battery
RR+
1 B
B
1
4
S21
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 2
2
RL–
6 B
W
3
8 IP2
S20
Door Speaker
Front LH No. 2
4
L
L
B
3 IP2
1 IA2
R
2
LG
3 IA2
R–L
2
2
1 A
6 A
V
P
1
FR+
FL–
2 A
P
Short Pin
140A ALT
2
Engine Control
System< 5–3> < 6–3>
2
1
R 2(A), R 3(B), R 4(C), R 5(D)
Radio and Player
FR–
RL+
5 A
2 B
P
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L–Y
GR
C
30 IC4
8 1K
29
L+
G
(∗1)
C
LG
(∗1)
J6
Junction
Connector
GR
28 IC4
2
R–
R
(∗1)
7 BJ1
R+
28
W
(∗1)
L–Y
(∗1)
6 BJ1
SG1
27
GR
C
5 1D
7. 5A
ACC
GR
(∗1)
W–L
L–Y
+B2
16
B
(∗1)
15
I18
Ignition SW
1
2
1
2
1
2
D23
R16
R17
Door Speaker
Front RH No. 1
Rear Door
Speaker LH
Rear Door
Speaker RH
10 C
TXM–
6 C
MUTE
A
B
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
490
(Cont. next page)
30 4RUNNER
30 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
A u d io S y s te m (6 S p e a k e r)
A
5
L–Y
8
7
6
P
L–Y
B
S h ift L o c k
R18
Rear Seat Audio Controller
OPEN
GND6
8
24
12
17 BJ1
9 BJ1
24 BJ1
10A
ECU–IG
LG
(∗1)
LG
(∗1)
(Shielded)
W
(∗1)
W
(∗1)
(Shielded)
W
(∗1)
GR
(∗1)
Combination Meter
< 31–6>
23 ID1
22 ID1
19 ID1
21 ID1
4 ID1
20 ID1
J20
Junction
Connector
13 ID1
AUXR
S6
Shift Lock Control ECU
6
8
AUXL
CE
D
E
12
8
1
B–R
B–R
V14
Video Terminal
IG
L–W
ASGN
II1
AU1
4
AUXO
AU2
SEEK+
B 3F
A 3B
B
3F
J15
Junction
Connector
ASGN
EAU
3
A
MODE
W–B
B 3F
A
A
BR
(∗1)
VOL+
IJ
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
Left Kick
Panel
IG
A
A
IK
J37
Junction
Connector
Right Kick
Panel
A
J24
Junction
Connector
II
Instrument
Panel Brace RH
M
491
VOL–
J5
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
W–B
S31
Stereo Jack Adapter
W–B
W–B
SEEK–
BR
C13
Combination SW
ARO
3
11
L
ALO
B
G
R
2
A 3B
W–B
10
Y–B
12
1
II1
W–R
V–W
4 IV1
2
B–R
1
K3
Key Interlock Solenoid
II1
A 3D
4
BR
3
GND
7 A
Y–B
W–R
V–W
3 IV1
SW2
8 D
L
(Shielded)
G
2 IV1
AUXI
19 D
A 3D
L–W
16 D
1 IJ1
R 2(A), R 3(B), R 4(C), R 5(D)
Radio and Player
SW1
SWG
7 D
6 D
W–B
ARI
15 D
R
1 IV1
J12
Junction
Connector
SPD
ANT
ALI
D
STP
KLS+
3 D
7
ACC
2
B–R
G–Y
P
SGND
BR
(∗1)
SGND
1
G
(∗1)
3
(Shielded)
NTSC
6
LG
(∗1)
V–R
SLD
V
(∗1)
5
(Shielded)
R
(∗1)
G
(∗1)
7
17 D
G
G
24 ID1
+B
8 A
28 1J
B–R
16 BJ1
2 1C
Stop Light SW
< 11–1>
18 BJ1
BR
(∗1)
15 BJ1
AUXL
7
G
(∗1)
R
(∗1)
14 BJ1
AUXR
(Shielded)
G
(∗1)
13 BJ1
SG7
23
LG
(∗1)
22
V
(∗1)
SGN5
6
(Shielded)
NTS4
1
B
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
A37
Antenna
Amplifier
SGN2
25
∗ 1 : w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
R
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
B–W
B–W
A/C Control
Assembly< 32–11>
B
Active Height Control
Suspension System< 18–6> < 18–7>
Electric Modulated
Air Suspension System< 18–6> < 18–7>
Multiplex Communication
System (BEAN)< 7–33> < 7–34>
Injector No. 1< 5–10>
< 6–10>
Taillight and Illumination
System< 10–11>
R–L
Suspension Control
ECU< 18–5>
Engine Control
Module
< 5–17> < 6–17>
Data Link
Connector 3
< 6–6>
B–W
(1GR–FE)
B–W
(2UZ–FE)
F14
Fuel Sender
3
Park/Neutral Position SW
< 1–2>
A/C Control Assembly
< 32–11>
BR–R
Y–B
F A
F A
R
B–W
Y–B
BR–R
L–B
B–Y
R–L
Short Pin
30A AM2
2
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
B–O
R–L
W–L
BR–B
Door
Front Fog
Beam
Illumination
Illumination
Head (USA)
Tail (Except USA)
2
4
N
R
W
8 IM2
R
A/C Control
Assembly
< 32–12>
Taillight and
Illumination
System< 10–11>
L
3
D
R
P
OFF
LO
N
HI
10A DOME
Battery
Multiplex
Communication
System (BEAN)
< 7–34>
B–R
R
R
2
H B
2 IE1
1 IE1
2
6 B
11 C
3 C
7 B
16 B
7 C
8 B
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
2 A
3 A
4 A
5 A
Combination Meter
17 A
2
F B
R
2
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
2
2
Buzzer
13 D
1
16 C
5 C
15 C
3 B
2 B
9 C
12 D
10 D
14 D
15 D
16 D
17 D
18 D
19 D
1 C
20 D
D B
J7
Junction
Connector
Height Control
2
H A
ST2
11 1J
4 1G
B A
10A
IGN
Electronically Controlled Transmission
and A/T Indicator System
< 13–8> < 13–10> < 13–11> < 13–12> < 14–10> < 14–11>
IG2 6
7 AM2
B–O
6 1D
IG1
AM1
F A
1
1
ACC
B–R
2
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
492
D
4
3
2
1
B–O
I18
Ignition SW
10 IC4
C o m b in a tio n M e te r
P o w e r S o u rc e
7. 5A
GAUGE
D
(Cont. next page)
31 4RUNNER
∗ 1 : w/ Moon Roof
∗ 2 : Canada
∗ 3 : Except 6 Speaker
C o m b in a tio n M e te r
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning Light
System< 8–4> < 9–4>
Body ECU
< 7–39>
V–R
V
(∗1)
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
V–R
DAC
Slip
VSC TRAC
VSC OFF (4WD)
AUTO LSD (2WD)
A/T OIL TEMP
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
V–W
(∗2)
ABS System< 15–7>
TRAC System< 15–7>
VSC System< 15–7>
Auto LSD System< 15–7>
Downhill Assist Control System
< 15–7>
Hill–Start Assist Control System
< 15–7>
J2
Junction
Connector
Electronically Controlled
Transmission and
A/T Indicator System
< 13–7> < 14–11>
Engine Control
System< 5–9> < 6–9>
W–B
(∗2)
Multi Mode 4WD
System< 19–5>
W1
Washer Level
Sensor
O1
Oil Pressure SW
LG–B
Charging System
< 4–3>
SRS System
< 20–6>
ABS System< 15–8>
TRAC System< 15–8>
VSC System< 15–8>
Auto LSD System< 15–8>
Downhill Assist Control
System< 15–8>
Hill–Start Assist Control
System< 15–8>
W–B
(∗2)
BR
(2UZ–FE)
Multiplex Communication
System (BEAN)< 7–33> < 7–34> < 7–35>
Multiplex Communication
System (BEAN)< 7–34>
Front Left
Fender
BR
(1GR–FE)
ABS System< 15–7>
TRAC System< 15–7>
VSC System< 15–7>
Auto LSD System< 15–7>
Downhill Assist Control
System< 15–7>
Hill–Start Assist Control
System< 15–7>
A
4LO
4WD
V–W
(∗2)
LG–B
BR
2
Center Diff. Lock
Washer
Oil Pressure
Turn RH
Charge
Turn LH
BRAKE
ABS
SRS
MAINT
Fuel
Driver' s
Seat Belt
Temp.
Fuel
Tachometer
1
1
18 C
Speedometer
7 IM1
20 C
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
6 IM1
12 A
17 C
15 A
7 A
7 D
6 D
5 D
6 A
16 A
Combination Meter
6 C
10 C
EB
Left Bank
Cylinder Head
ED
A
EE
M
493
Rear Side of Right
Bank Cylinder Block
Engine Control Module
< 5–17> < 6–17>
8 A
19 A
4 D
2 C
13 C
4 B
Tire Pressure
Warning ECU
< 26–3>
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
5 B
4WD Control ECU
< 19–1>
V–R
(4WD)
G
B
V–R
G
B
G
A
V–R
(∗3)
41
IO2
V–R
(∗3)
Stereo Component
Amplifier
< 28–12> < 29–11>
1 1G
18 B
13 B
8 C
12 B
19 B
V–R
Moon Roof
Control ECU
< 24–2>
8
7
6
5
V–R
G
B
V–R
G
A
B
3D
11 1K
V–R
Radio and Player with Display
< 28–9>
Radio and Player
< 30–5>
B
3D
A/C Control Assembly
< 32–11>
V–R
B
3D
B
3D
5 1A
(Cont. next page)
31 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
7 IN1
C o m b in a tio n M e te r
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
CRUISE
RSCA OFF
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
Tire Pressure
11 A
10 A
1 A
10
11
12
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
494
31 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
9
Cruise Control
System< 16–4> < 17–4>
SRS System
< 20–5>
Tire Pressure Warning System
< 26–2>
Memo
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
495
P o w e r S o u rc e
A ir C o n d itio n in g
1
4
3
2
W–R
Y–R
A
B
R
Y–R
W–R
D
W–G
IG1 4
L–Y
2 AM1
D
P
Y–R
5 1D
R
4 1L
C
W–G
Y–R
J7
Junction
Connector
ACC 3
2
1
Y–R
R
4 1B
2
C
D
A 3C
GR
J6
Junction
Connector
ACC
GND
LIN–B
IG+
8
7
14
2
D3
Heater
Control
Panel
Y–R
W–B
GR
GR
L–B
W–G
W–G
3
W–B
B 3A
B 3A
L
W–B
LG–B
J24
Junction
Connector
A
II
J37
Junction
Connector
W–B
Instrument Panel
Brace RH
W–B
(2UZ–FE)
Y–G
Y–G
LG–B
A
F
G
H
I
B 3F
2
A
E
W–B
3
IM2
B 3F
D
B 3F
W–B
B
Y–G
B 3F
B
3F
2
SI
1
EB
2
IM2
VM
GND
Battery
C
C
W–G
1
W–L
B3
Blower Motor
Controller
+B
B
A2
A/C Lock Sensor
A/C Magnetic Clutch
4
1
BR–Y
G–Y
W–B
3
Front Left
Fender
F 3E
30 IC4
L–B
G–Y
Short Pin
60A HEATER
1
B2
Blower Motor
M
40 IC4
2
L–B
2
2
1
1 IC4
3 IM1
L
2
37 IC4
B–Y
J3
Junction
Connector
B
R
W
B
2
2
A 3C
R
43 IC4
Engine Control
System< 5–3> < 6–3>
J1
Junction Connector
BR–Y
36 IC4
7. 5A
HEATER
NO. 2
B
2
GR
E
L–B
L
B–Y
W–B
2
1
2
F 3E
B–Y
2
2
2
2
BR–Y
Y–R
Y–R
E
1
2
1
E
E
J8
Junction
Connector
38 IC4
2
2
140A ALT
1
Y–R
Y–R
E
10A DOME
10A ECU–B
1
2
20 1E
2
2
4
2
HEATER
Relay
3
2
2
P
50A AM1
4
3
H
8 1K
R
2
1
1
2
MG CLT
Relay
H
P
R
W–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
C
D
2
3
P
2
5
1
ACC CUT
Relay
2
2
2
2
2
5
J1
Junction
Connector
15A IG1
10 IC4
2
2
7. 5A ACC
8 1J
Y–R
R
W–L
2 1C
I18
Ignition SW
IK
Right Kick
Panel
J
K
L
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
496
(Cont. next page)
32 4RUNNER
(Cont. next page)
32 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
∗ 1 : Limited
∗ 2 : Except Limited
A ir C o n d itio n in g
A
B
C
5
W–R
Y–R
A16(A), A17(B)
A/C Control Assembly
Y–R
1
IG
1 A
PSW
9 B
LIN1
4 A
MGC
10 B
LOCK
19 A
GMD
5 A
HR
21 A
BLW
3 A
S5
TR
1 B
15 A
P–G
3
4
M
5
A25
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
4 B (∗2)
M
1
A1
A/C Ambient
Temp. Sensor
1 A (∗1)
1 B
2 B (∗2)
2
5 IC3
2
1
Y–G
2 A
P
Y–G
L–B
Y–G
BR–Y
W–G
Y–G
Y–G
Y–G
Y–G
A
W–B
Y–G
L
AIF
6 B
P–L
5 A (∗1)
5 B
Y–G
Y–G
K
AIR
5 B
P–B
4 A
3 B
GR
A
Y–G
J
TPI
16 A
GR
2
A
3 A
P
Y–R
I
TAM
22 A
V–W
A27(A)
Air Mix Control
Servo Motor LH
A26(B)
Air Mix Control
Servo Motor
1
A19
A/C Room Temp. Sensor
Y–R
H
J7
Junction
Connector
G
V–R
B 3E
W–R
LG–R
F
L–O
Y–G
Y–R
Y–R
LG–R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
E
Y–R
AMHDR(∗1)
AMH(∗2)
14 B
39 IC4
H
J20
Junction
Connector
AMCDR(∗1)
AMC(∗2)
23 B
A
H
5 IN1
TPDR(∗1)
TP(∗2)
25 A
SG
6 A
V–Y
P
LG–B
L
W–B
W–G
BR–Y
L–B
LG–R
A
VER1
8 B
W–B
(2UZ–FE)
Y–R
A
J25
Junction
Connector
W–R
P3
Pressure SW
+B
2 A
B 3E
2
D
8
7
6
W–B
(2UZ–FE)
B 3B
P
B
3B
B 3B
B
Y–G
L
LG–B
M
497
A ir C o n d itio n in g
7 A
W–L
Combination
Meter< 31–4>
V–G
(∗2)
R
(∗1)
B–O
(∗1)
L–B
L–B
GR–G
BR–W
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction Connector
J10(A), J11(B)
Junction Connector
A28
Air Mix Control Servo Motor RH
A29
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
L–B
Y–G
P
Y–G
(∗1)
P
(∗1)
Y–G
L–B
P
(∗2)
P
(∗1)
A18
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A21
A/C Solar Sensor
A20
A/C Solar Sensor
Combination
Meter< 31–3> < 31–4>
1 IK1
BR–B
GR–G
BR–W
L–B
V–R
B–W
R
(∗1)
B–O
(∗1)
G
L–Y
(∗1)
L–R
(∗1)
L–W
(∗1)
LG–R
LG
LG–R
H B
I B
Engine Control Module
< 5–19> < 6–15>
Combination Meter
< 31–4> < 31–6>
E A
D A
C 3D
C 3D
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
P
(∗2)
P
(∗1)
B
3B
B
B 3B
B 3B
M
M
6 IG1
5 IG1
1
1
2
1
2
1
Y–G
Y–G
A
2
2
3
2
1
C 3D
5 IG1
6 IG1
4 IG1
2 IK1
5
4
3
5
4
3
V–G
(∗2)
20 B
19 B
DMIN
DMOT
AC1
7 B
ACT
18 A
TWI
SPD
TABC
8 A
20 A
TSDR(∗1)
TS(∗2)
12 A
TSPA
TE
AMCPA
26 A
24 A
24 B
16 B
23 A
3 B
AMHPA
TPPA
AOF
AOD
TPO
4 B
17 A
12
11
10
9
∗ 1 : Limited
∗ 2 : Except Limited
A/C Control Assembly
A16(A), A17(B)
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
498
32 4RUNNER (Cont' d)
33 4RUNNER
P o w e r S e a t (D riv e r' s S e a t w / D riv in g P o s itio n M e m o ry )
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
4
3
2
R–L
R–B
35 IE1
M2
2
6 IE1
9 BK1
3
LG
34 IE1
M1
R–L
MRY
1
V
J39
F
Junction
Connector
W–B
E
S30
Seat Memory SW
P
F
E
LG
E
G–B
10A ECU–IG
4 1B
8 IE1
7 IE1
A
G–B
R–B
LG
6 BK1
8 BK1
2 BK1
15 BK1
V
W–R
B–R
1 1C
P
B–R
5 BK1
8 1F
J53
Junction
Connector
A
LG
W–L
W–R
A
17 BK1
16 BK1
2
LG
V
P
LG
P
2
5 B
DCTY
MMRY
2 B
6 B
SW1
SW2
5 A
+B
3
2
SLD–
3 A
FRV+
6 A
FRV–
4 A
RCL+
8 A
RCL–
10 A
LFT+
7 A
LFT–
9 A
GND
1 A
W–B
W–B
W–B
W
V
BR
P
G
B
L
1
2 A
Y
1
50A
AM1
2
1
B
B
B
1
M
J53
Junction
Connector
2
Lumbar Support
Control SW
(Driver' s Seat)
W–B
M
L3
4
Y
1
1
P21
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Lifter Control)
M
P23
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Reclining Control)
1
2
B
M
W–B
V
P
B
2
M
L
2
2
P20
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Front Vertical Control)
1
1
P24
Power Seat Motor
(Driver' s Seat
Slide Control)
140A
ALT
Short
Pin
1
W
2
2
Hold
50A
J/B
Release
SLD+
2
5
2
P27(A), P28(B)
Position Control ECU and SW
2
2
3 B
LG
2
7 B
SYSB
W–B
W–B
8 B
IG
2
Y
4 B
1
GR
W
O
L–W
10A
ECU–B
W
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
30A D P/SEAT
I18
Ignition SW
W–R
B–R
2 1C
29 1J
2
L–Y
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH< 7–31>
R–L
W–R
12 1F
IG1 4
Park/Neutral
Position SW
< 13–12> < 14–10>
ACC
2 AM1
24 IE1
4
B
B
2
L5
Lumbar Support
Control Motor
(Driver' s Seat)
D B
J22(A), J23(B)
Junction
Connector
1 BK1
E A
W–B
W–B
Battery
A
J5
Junction
Connector
BL
Left Kick
Panel
IG
M
499
Floor Seat
Crossmember LH
[A]
Power Source
Starting
1
Engine Control
2
4
3
R
[L]
B-R
B-R
15A
EFI
[H]
12 EA1
R-Y
R-Y
1
[E]
1
3
Knock Sensor
1
B
B
BR
BR
3
B
B
1
GR
GR
4
B-W
4
EFI MAIN
Relay
B-R
B-W
1
H11
Heated
Oxygen
Sensor
2
Y-R
[G]
1
15 3C
R-G
W-B
B-W
(2L-T)
(2L-T)
4
6
1
R-W
5
BO2
Y-R
3
BR-W
BR-W
6
G
G
5
G-R
G-R
4
Y-R
7
L-Y
BR 2
1
FP
+B
T1
D1
Data Link
Connector 1
E1
8
Y-R
6
G-Y
G-Y
9
GR-B
GR-B
W-R
W-R
BR
Fender Apron LH
EA
BR
W-B
W-B
Fender Apron LH
N
O
21 EA3
B
BR
W-R
VF
4
3
[K]
EA
L
M
Y-R
R-G
BR
W-B
W-R
W-R
Fuel Pump
1
F37
M
OX1
17
EA3
R-G
2
1
W-R
W-R
W-R
W-R
I12
1
4 EA3
R-G
2
Injector No.4
1
I10
Injector No.2
I11
1
2
L-Y
W-R
Battery
K
16 BS1
B-R
2
Injector No.3
I9
S38 (A), S39 (B)
Starter
B-R
B-R
B-R
Injector No.1
B-W
2
1 A
Y-R
Y-R
R-G
B-R
30A AM2
40A AM1
100A ALT
(2L-T)
1
B
J
Air Flow Meter
W-B
[D]
B-W
B
Y-R
A5
6 EA4
2
[J]
Y-R
2 B
Circuit Opening
Relay
R-G
2 A
C19
Y-R
S40 (A), S41 (B)
Starter Relay
(Shielded)
[C]
2
1 B
F
G
I
3
[F]
7 3C
Emission ECU <9-8>
2
2
Y-R
B-W
W-R
W
[B]
E
H
B-W
(22R-E)
1 A
2
Y-R
Y-R
W-B
B-W
(22R-E)
B-L
(2L-T)
B-W(22R-E)
D
2
1
1
(2L-T)
R
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
7 EA3
(22R-E)
(2L-T)
[I]
C
K2
B-L
R-Y
B-L
W
B
W-R
B-R
B-R
2
A
7. 5A
IGN
B-W
ST2
7. 5A
ST
B-W
5 8
AM2
A B
7
IG2
B
B-W
(22R-E)
W-R
W
W-R
1 4
B A
B-W
ST1
B-W
W
1 4
AM1
A B
B-L
ACC I 6 (A),(B)
Ignition SW
IG1
A
ID
Left Kick Panel
BR
EC
Intake
Manifold RH
P
Q
R
S
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
412
* The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the
actual circuit shown in the wiring diagram section.
HOW TO READ THIS SECTION
[A] : System Title
[B] : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B
= Black
W = White
BR = Brown
L
= Blue
V
SB = Sky Blue
= Violet
R = Red
G = Green
LG = Light Green
P
Y
GR = Gray
= Pink
= Yellow
[F] : Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No.
and the connector code is shown beside it).
Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly separate them
from other parts.
Example:
3C indicates that
it is inside
Junction Block
No.3
O = Orange
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Example:
L–Y
[G] : Indicates related system.
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
L
(Blue)
[H] : Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows ( ).
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
Y
(Yellow)
[C] : The position of the parts is the same as shown in
the wiring diagram and wire routing.
[D] : Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female
and male connectors.
Example : Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Female
[I]
Male (
)
: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine type,
or specification is different.
[J] : Indicates a shielded cable.
Female
Male
The numbering system for the overall wiring diagram is
the same as above
[E] : Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish
it from the J/B.
Example :
[K] : Indicates and located on ground point.
[L] : The same code occuring on the next page indicates
that the wire harness is continuous.
Indicates Relay Block No.1
M
413
SYSTEMS
LOCATION
4RUNNER (EM03M0U)
ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Active Height Control Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–2
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32–2
Audio System (w/ Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–2
Audio System (10 Speaker) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29–2
Audio System (6 Speaker) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30–2
Auto LSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Automatic Glare–Resistant EC Mirror with Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . 24–1
Back–Up Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12–2
Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25–3
Combination Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31–2
Cruise Control (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17–2
Cruise Control (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–2
Downhill Assist Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Electric Modulated Air Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–2
Electric Tension Reducer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26–4
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
(1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14–2
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
(2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13–2
Engine Control (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–2
Engine Control (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–2
Engine Immobiliser System (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–19
Engine Immobiliser System (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–19
Front Wiper and Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21–2
Hill–Start Assist Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26–1
Ignition (1GR–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2
Ignition (2UZ–FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2
Illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–2
Moon Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24–2
Multi Mode 4WD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19–2
Multiplex Communication System (BEAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7–3
∗ Automatic Light Control
∗ Door Lock Control
SYSTEMS
LOCATION
∗ Front Fog Light
∗ Garage Door Opener
∗ Headlight
∗ Interior Light
∗ Key Reminder
∗ Light Auto Turn Off System
∗ Mirror Heater
∗ Power Window
∗ Rear Window Defogger
∗ Rear Wiper and Washer
∗ Seat Belt Warning
∗ Theft Deterrent
∗ Wireless Door Lock Control
Multiplex Communication System (CAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–11
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–2
Parking Assist (Rear View Monitor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–2
Power Outlet (115V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25–2
Power Outlet (12V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25–4
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/ Driving Position Memory) . . . . . . . . . . 33–2
Power Seat (Driver’s Seat w/o Driving Position Memory) . . . . . . . . 22–2
Power Seat (Front Passenger’s Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22–4
Power Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1~33–1
Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24–3
Seat Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23–2
Shift Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30–7
SRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20–2
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2
Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11–2
Taillight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–2
Tire Pressure Warning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26–2
TRAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27–2
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light
(w/ Daytime Running Light) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8–2
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light
(w/o Daytime Running Light) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9–2
VSC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
414
SYSTEM INDEX
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–27
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT
LOCATIONS
1.
2.
3.
NOTICE ABOUT VEHICLE CONDITION WHEN
JACKING UP
(a) As a rule, the vehicle must be unloaded when
jacking up. Never jack up or lift up the vehicle
loaded with things of heavy weight.
(b) When removing any parts of heavy weight like the
engine and transmission, the center of gravity of the
vehicle moves. Place a balance weight so as to
keep it from rolling, or hold the jacking support
location using the mission jack.
NOTICE FOR USING 4 POST LIFT
(a) Follow the instruction manual for a safety operation.
(b) Do not damage tires or wheels with a free wheel
beam.
(c) Using a wheel stopper, fix the vehicle.
NOTICE FOR USING JACK AND SAFETY STAND
(a) Work in the flat place using a wheel stopper at all
times.
(b) Use a safety stand with a rubber attachment, as
shown in the illustration.
(c) Support the specified location with a jack and safety
stand accurately.
(d) When jacking up the front wheels, release the
parking brake and place wheel stoppers only behind
the rear wheels. When jacking up the rear wheels,
place wheel stoppers only in front of the front
wheels.
(e) Do not work or leave the vehicle supported only by a
jack. Be sure to support the vehicle with a safety
stand.
(f) When jacking up only the front wheels or only the
rear wheels, place wheel stoppers to both sides of
the wheels that contact ground.
IN
IN–28
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(g) When jacking down the vehicle with its front wheels
jacked up, release the parking brake and place
wheel stoppers only in front of the rear wheels.
When jacking down the vehicle with its rear wheels
jacked up, place wheel stoppers only behind the
front wheels.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–29
IN
Front
JACK POSITION
Front
Center of crossmember
Rear
Center of rear axle housing
CAUTION: When jacking up the front and rear, make sure the
vehicle is not carrying any extra weight.
SUPPORT POSITION
Safety stand
Swing arm type lift
D029295E02
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–39
ELECTRONIC CIRCUIT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
1.
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
CORRECT
D032092E01
Looseness of
Crimping
Core Wire
Terminal
Deformation
Pull Lightly
D025087E03
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) WHEN MEASURING RESISTANCE OF
ELECTRONIC PARTS
(1) Unless otherwise stated, all resistance
measurements should be made at an ambient
temperature of 20°C (68°F). Resistance
measurements may be inaccurate if measured
at high temperatures, i.e. immediately after the
vehicle has been running. Measurements should
be made after the engine has cooled down.
(b) HANDLING CONNECTORS
(1) When disconnecting a connector, first squeeze
the mating connector housing halves tightly
together to release the lock, and then press the
lock claw and separate the connector.
(2) When disconnecting a connector, do not pull on
the harnesses. Grasp the connector directly and
separate it.
(3) Before connecting a connector, check that there
are no deformations, damage, looseness or
missing terminals.
(4) When connecting a connector, press firmly until
it locks with a "click" sound.
(5) If checking a connector with a TOYOTA
electrical tester, check the connector from the
backside (harness side) using a mini test lead.
NOTICE:
• As a waterproof connector cannot be
checked from the backside, check it by
connecting a sub-harness.
• Do not damage the terminals by moving
the inserted tester needle.
(c) CHECKING CONNECTORS
(1) Checking when a connectors is disconnected:
Squeeze the connector together to confirm that
they are fully connected and locked.
(2) Checking when a connector is disconnected:
Check by pulling the wire harness lightly from
the backside of the connector. Look for
unlatched terminals, missing terminals, loose
crimps or broken conductor wires. Check
visually for corrosion, metallic or foreign matter
and water, and bent, rusted, overheated,
contaminated, or deformed terminals.
IN
IN–40
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
(3) Checking the contact pressure of the terminal:
Prepare a spare male terminal. Insert it into a
female terminal, and check for ample tension
when inserting and after full engagement.
NOTICE:
When testing a gold-plated female terminal,
always use a gold-plated male terminal.
IN
D025088E02
(d) REPAIR METHOD OF CONNECTOR TERMINAL
(1) If there is any foreign matter on the terminal,
clean the contact point with compressed air or a
cloth. Never rub the contact point using
sandpaper as the plating may come off.
(2) If there is abnormal contact pressure, replace
the female terminal. If the male terminal is goldplated (gold color), use a gold-plated female
terminal; if it is silver-plated (silver color), use a
silver-plated female terminal.
(3) Damaged, deformed, or corroded terminals
should be replaced. If the terminal does not lock
into the housing, the housing may have to be
replaced.
INCORRECT
CORRECT
D032093E01
(e) HANDLING OF WIRE HARNESS
(1) If removing a wire harness, check the wiring and
clamping before proceeding so that it can be
restored in the same way.
(2) Never twist, pull or slacken the wire harness
more than necessary.
(3) The wire harness should never come into
contact with a high temperature part, or rotating,
moving, vibrating or sharp-edged parts. Avoid
contact with panel edges, screw tips and other
sharp items.
(4) When installing parts, never pinch the wire
harness.
(5) Never cut or break the cover of the wire harness.
If it is cut or broken, replace it or repair it with
vinyl tape.
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
Fig. 1
D032094E01
ECU
B
C OPEN
1
1
2
2
A
1
2
1
2
SENSOR
Z017004E02
2.
CHECK FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
(a) For an open circuit in the wire harness in Fig. 1, the
resistance or voltage, as described below.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Fig. 2
ECU
1
1
1
2
2
2
SENSOR C
A
B
Z017005E02
IN–41
(b) Check the resistance.
(1) Disconnect connectors A and C and measure
the resistance between the terminals of the
connectors.
Standard resistance (Fig. 2)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Connector
C terminal 1
10 kΩ or higher
Connector A terminal 2 - Connector
C terminal 2
Below 1Ω
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the
wire harness vertically and horizontally. If the
results match the examples above, an open
circuit exists between terminal 1 of connector A
and terminal 1 of connector C.
Fig. 3
ECU
SENSOR
(2) Disconnect connector B and measure the
resistance between the terminals of the
connectors.
Standard resistance (Fig. 3)
Tester connection
1
2
1
2
C
1
1
2
B2
2
B1
A
B004722E03
Fig. 4
ECU
5V
SENSOR 0 V
1
2
C
5V 1
2
2
B
1
2
A
Z017007E02
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Connector
B1 terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
Connector B2 terminal 2 - Connector
C terminal 2
10 kΩ or higher
If the results match the examples above, an
open circuit exists between terminal 1 of
connector B2 and terminal 1 of connector C.
(c) Check the voltage.
(1) In a circuit in which voltage is applied to the ECU
connector terminal, an open circuit can be
checked by conducting a voltage check.
With each connector still connected, measure
the voltage between the body ground and these
terminals (in this order): 1) terminal 1 of
connector A, 2) terminal 1 of connector B, and 3)
terminal 1 of connector C.
Standard voltage (Fig. 4)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Body
ground
5V
Connector B terminal 1 - Body
ground
5V
Connector C terminal 1 - Body
ground
Below 1 V
If the results match the examples above, an
open circuit exists in the wire harness between
terminal 1 of connector B and terminal 1 of
connector C.
IN
IN–42
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Fig. 5
ECU
SHORT
1
2
IN
1
1
2
2
CHECK FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
(a) If the wire harness is ground shorted (Fig. 5), locate
the section by conducting a resistance check with
the body ground (below).
A
B
C
3.
Z017008E02
(b) Check the resistance with the body ground.
(1) Disconnect connectors A and C and measure
the resistance.
Standard resistance (Fig. 6)
Fig. 6
ECU
SENSOR
1
1
2
2
C
Tester Connection
1
2
A
B
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Body
ground
Below 1 Ω
Connector A terminal 2 - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Z017009E02
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the
wire harness vertically and horizontally. If your
results match the examples above, an open
circuit exists between terminal 1 of connector A
and terminal 1 of connector C.
(2) Disconnect connector B and measure the
resistance.
Standard resistance (Fig. 7)
Fig. 7
ECU
SENSOR
1
2
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
A
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Connector B2 terminal 2 - Body
ground
Below 1 Ω
Z017808E02
4.
If the results match the examples above, a short
circuit exists between terminal 1 of connector B2
and terminal 1 of connector C.
CHECK AND REPLACE ECU
NOTICE:
• The connector should not be disconnected from
the ECU. Perform the inspection from the
backside of the connector on the wire harness
side.
• When no measuring condition is specified,
perform the inspection with the engine stopped
and the ignition switch on.
• Check that the connectors are fully seated. Check
for loose, corroded or broken wires.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Example:
Ground
IN00383E02
ECU Side
Wire Harness Side
W/H Side
Ground
Ground
IN00384E03
IN–43
(a) First, check the ECU ground circuit. If it is faulty,
repair it. If it is normal, the ECU could be faulty.
Temporarily replace the ECU with a normally
functioning one and check if the symptoms occur. If
the trouble symptoms disappear, replace the
original ECU.
(1) Measure the resistance between the ECU
ground terminal and body ground.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(2) Disconnect the ECU connector. Check the
ground terminal on the ECU side and wire
harness side for bending, corrosion or foreign
matter. Lastly, check the contact pressure of the
female terminals.
IN
IN–49
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA
TERMS
This glossary lists all SAE-J1930 terms and abbreviations
used in this manual in compliance with SAE
recommendations, as well as their TOYOTA equivalents.
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
A/C
TOYATA TERMS
( )-ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner, A/CL
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
-
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
+B, Battery Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
HAC
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
-
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
-
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
-
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
LL ON, Idle ON
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection
Direct Injection (DI./INJ)
DI
Distributor Ignition
-
DLC3
Data Link Connector 3
OBD II Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Trouble Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
-
ECL
Engine Coolant Level
-
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine Electronic Control Unit (ECU)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM), Erasable Programmable Read
Only Memory (EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
Distributorless Ignition (DLI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
-
FEEPROM
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
-
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
-
FF
Flexible Fuel
-
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
-
IN
IN–50
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
IN
TOYATA TERMS
( )-ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
Indirect Injection (IDL)
IFS
Inertia Fuel-Shutoff
-
ISC
Idle Speed Control
-
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Airflow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure Intake Vacuum
MC
Mixture Control
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
-
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Light
Check Engine Light
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
-
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
-
NVRAM
Non-Volatile Random Access Memory
-
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On-Board Diagnostic
On-Board Diagnostic System (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalytic Convert (OC), CCo
OL
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
-
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
-
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
-
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
-
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
RAM
Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory (RAM)
RM
Relay Module
-
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
E-ABV
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
-
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
-
SRT
System Readiness Test
-
ST
Scan Tool
-
TB
Throttle Body
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU, ECT ECU
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
-
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
TWC
Three-Way Catalytic Converter
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC)
Manifold Converter
CCRO
IN–51
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
TOYATA TERMS
( )-ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
TWC+OC
Three-Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Airflow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU-OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
-
WU-TWC
Warm Up Three-Way Catalytic Converter
-
3GR
Third Gear
-
4GR
Fourth Gear
-
IN
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN–1
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.
2.
3.
4.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
(a) This manual is written in accordance with SAE
J2008.
(1) Diagnosis
(2) Removing / Installing, Replacing, Disassembling
/ Reassembling, Checking and Adjusting
(3) Final Inspection
(b) The following procedures are omitted from this
manual. However, these procedures must be
performed.
(1) Use a jack or lift to perform operations
(2) Clean all removed parts
(3) Perform a visual check
INDEX
(a) An alphabetical INDEX section is provided at the
end of the manual as a reference to help you find
the item to be repaired.
PREPARATION
(a) Use of Special Service Tools (SST) and Special
Service Materials (SSM) may be required,
depending on the repair procedure. Be sure to use
SST and SSM when they are required and follow
the working procedure properly. A list of SST and
SSM is in the "Preparation" section of this manual.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
(a) A component illustration is placed under the title
where necessary.
(b) Non-reusable parts, grease application areas,
precoated parts and torque specifications are noted
in the component illustrations.
The following illustration is an example.
IN
IN–2
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Example:
Filter Cap
Clevis Pin
Float
Gasket
Reservoir Tank
IN
Washer
Grommet
Slotted Spring Pin
Clip
12 (120,9)
Clevis
Lock Nut
15 (155,11)
Push Rod
Cylinder
Boot
Snap Ring
Piston
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
N017080E11
(c) Torque specifications, grease application areas and
non-reusable parts are emphasized in the
procedures.
HINT:
There are cases where such information can only
be explained by using an illustration. In these cases,
torque, oil and other information are described in the
illustration.
(d) Only items with key points are described in the text.
What to do and other details are explained using
illustrations next to the text. Both the text and
illustrations are accompanied by standard values
and notices.
Illustration
What to do and where to do it
Task heading
What work will be performed
Explanation text
How to perform the task
Also has information such as specifications and warnings, which are
written in boldface text
5.
6.
CAUTION
(e) Illustrations of similar vehicle models are sometimes
used. In these cases, minor details may be different
from the actual vehicle.
(f) Procedures are presented in a step-by-step format.
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
(a) SPECIFICATIONS are presented in boldface text
throughout the manual. The specifications are also
found in the "Service Specifications" section for
reference.
TERM DEFINITIONS
Possibility of injury to you or other people.
NOTICE
Possibility of damage to components being repaired.
HINT
Provides additional information to help you perform repairs.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
7.
IN–3
INTERNATIONAL SYSTEM OF UNITS
(a) The units used in this manual comply with the
International System of Units (SI UNIT) standard.
Units from the metric system and the English
systems are also provided.
Example:
Torque: 30 N*m (310 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
IN
IN–4
INTRODUCTION – IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
A
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION AND
SERIAL NUMBERS
IN
1.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
(a) The vehicle identification number is stamped on the
vehicle body and on the certification label, as shown
in the illustration.
A:
Vehicle Identification Number
B:
Certification Label
2.
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER AND TRANSMISSION
SERIAL NUMBER
(a) The engine serial number is stamped on the
cylinder block of the engine, and the transmission
serial number is stamped on the housing, as shown
in the illustration.
A:
Engine Serial Number
B:
Transmission Serial Number
B
D027510E01
1GR-FE
A
2UZ-FE
A750E, A750F
B
B089792E01
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–5
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
PRECAUTION
1.
BASIC REPAIR HINT
(a) HINTS ON OPERATIONS
IN
D028947
1
Attire
•
•
2
Vehicle protection
Prepare a grille cover, fender cover, seat cover and floor mat before starting the
operation.
3
Safety operation
•
•
•
•
•
Always wear a clean uniform.
Hat and safety shoes must be worn.
When working with 2 or more persons, be sure to check safety for one another.
When working with the engine running, make sure to provide ventilation for exhaust
fumes in the workshop.
If working on high temperature, high pressure, rotating, moving, or vibrating parts,
wear appropriate safety equipment and take extra care not to injure yourself or
others.
When jacking up the vehicle, be sure to support the specified location with a safety
stand.
When lifting up the vehicle, use appropriate safety equipment.
4
Preparation of tools and
measuring gauge
Before starting operation, prepare a tool stand, SST, gauge, oil and parts for replacement.
5
Removal and installation,
disassembly and assembly
operations
•
•
•
•
Diagnose with a thorough understanding of proper procedures and of the reported
problem.
Before removing the parts, check the general condition of the assembly and for
deformation and damage.
When the assembly is complicated, take notes. For example, note the total number of
electrical connections, bolts, or hoses removed. Add matchmarks to insure
reassembly of components in the original positions. Temporarily mark hoses and their
fittings if needed.
Clean and wash the removed parts if necessary and assemble them after a thorough
check.
IN–6
6
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Removed parts
•
•
•
Place the removed parts in a separate box to avoid mixing them up with the new parts
or contaminating the new parts.
For non-reusable parts such as gaskets, O-rings, and self-locking nuts, replace them
with new ones as instructed in this manual.
Retain the removed parts for customer inspection, if requested.
(b) JACKING UP AND SUPPORTING VEHICLE
(1) Care must be taken when jacking up and
supporting the vehicle. Be sure to lift and
support the vehicle at the proper locations.
IN
Seal Lock Adhesive
Z011554E03
INCORRECT
CORRECT
(c) PRECOATED PARTS
(1) Precoated parts are bolts and nuts that are
coated with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(2) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
moved in any way, it must be recoated with the
specified adhesive.
(3) When reusing a precoated part, clean off the old
adhesive and dry the part with compressed air.
Then apply new seal lock adhesive appropriate
to that part.
(4) Some seal lock agents harden slowly. You may
have to wait for the seal lock adhesive to
harden.
(d) GASKETS
(1) When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to
prevent leaks.
(e) BOLTS, NUTS AND SCREWS
(1) Carefully follow all the specifications for
tightening torques. Always use a torque wrench.
(f)
FUSES
(1) When inspecting a fuse, check that the wire of
the fuse is not broken.
(2) When replacing fuses, be sure that the new fuse
has the correct amperage rating. Do not exceed
the rating or use one with a lower rating.
V035007E01
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
FUSE
FUSE
IN–7
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSE
M-FUSE
IN
HIGH CURRENT FUSE
H-FUSE
FUSIBLE LINK
FL
CIRCUIT BREAKER
CB
(g) CLIPS
(1) The removal and installation methods of typical
clips used for vehicle body parts are shown in
the table below.
HINT:
If clips are damaged during work, always replace
the damaged clip with a new one.
IN–8
Shape (Example)
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Removal/Installation
Remove clips with clip remover or pliers.
IN
Remove fasteners with clip remover or screwdriver.
Remove clips with wide scraper to prevent panel damage.
Remove clips by pushing center pin through and prying out shell.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Shape (Example)
IN–9
Removal/Installation
Remove clips by unscrewing center pin and prying out shell.
IN
Remove clips by prying out pin and then prying out shell.
(h) CLAWS
(1) The removal and installation methods of typical
claws used for vehicle body parts are shown in
the table below.
HINT:
If claws are damaged during a procedure,
always replace the damaged claws with a new
caps or covers.
Shape (Example)
Illustration
Procedures
1. Using a screwdriver, detach the claws
and remove the cap or covers.
1. Using a screwdriver, detach the claws
and remove the cap or covers.
IN–10
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Shape (Example)
Illustration
Procedures
1. Using a screwdriver, detach the claws
and remove the cap or covers.
IN
(i)
INCORRECT
CORRECT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF VACUUM
HOSES
(1) To disconnect a vacuum hose, pull and twist
from the end of the hose. Do not pull from the
middle of the hose as this may damage the
hose.
D031750E01
(2) When disconnecting vacuum hoses, use tags to
identify where they should be reconnected.
(3) After completing any hose related repairs,
double check that the vacuum hoses are
properly connected. The label under the hood
shows the proper layout.
(4) When using a vacuum gauge, never force the
hose onto a connector that is too large. If a hose
has been stretched, air may leak. Use a stepdown adapter if necessary.
D025064E01
(j)
L1
L2
D002612E02
TORQUE WHEN USING TORQUE WRENCH
WITH EXTENSION TOOL
IN–11
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
L1
(1) Use the formula below to calculate special
torque values for situations where SST or an
extension tool is combined with the torque
wrench.
Formula:
T' = L2/(L1 + L2) * T
L2
D001201E01
T'
Reading of torque wrench {N*m
(kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)}
T
Torque {N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)}
L1
Length of SST or extension tool {cm
(in.)}
L2
Length of torque wrench {cm (in.)}
2.
NOTICE:
If an extension tool or SST is combined with
a torque wrench and the wrench is used to
tighten to a torque specification in this
manual, the actual torque will be excessive
and parts will be damaged.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH SRS AIRBAG AND
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
The 4RUNNER is equipped with a Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS).
CAUTION:
Failure to carry out the service operations in the
correct sequence could cause the SRS to
unexpectedly deploy during servicing and lead to
serious injury. Furthermore, if a mistake is made
when servicing SRS, it is possible that the SRS may
fail to operate properly. Before servicing (including
removal or installation of parts, inspection or
replacement), be sure to read the following section
carefully.
(a) GENERAL NOTICE
(1) As malfunctions of the SRS are difficult to
confirm, the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
become the most important source of
information when troubleshooting. When
troubleshooting the SRS, always check the
DTCs before disconnecting the battery.
IN
IN–12
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(2) Work must be started at least 90 seconds after
the ignition switch is turned off and after the
cable is disconnected from the negative (-)
battery terminal.
The SRS is equipped with a back-up power
source. If work is started within 90 seconds after
turning the ignition switch off and disconnecting
the cable from the negative (-) battery terminal,
the SRS may deploy.
When the cable is disconnected from the
negative (-) battery terminal, clock and audio
system memory is erased. Before starting work,
make a note of the settings of each memory
system. When work is finished, reset the clock
and audio system as before.
CAUTION:
Never use a back-up power source (battery
or other) to avoid erasing system memory.
The back-up power source may inadvertently
power the SRS and cause it to deploy.
(3) In minor collisions where the SRS does not
deploy, the steering pad, front passenger airbag
assembly, front seat side airbag assembly,
curtain shield airbag assembly and front seat
outer belt assembly should be inspected before
further use of the vehicle.
(See page RS-389 for steering pad)
(See page RS-405 for front passenger airbag
assembly)
(See page RS-420 for front seat side airbag
assembly)
(See page RS-414 for curtain shield airbag
assembly)
(See page SB-12 for front seat outer belt
assembly)
(4) Never use SRS parts from another vehicle.
When replacing parts, use new parts.
(5) Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor
assemblies if impacts are likely to be applied to
the sensor during repairs.
(6) Never disassemble and attempt to repair all
airbag sensor assemblies and all airbag
assemblies.
1. Steering pad
2. Front passenger airbag assembly
3. Front seat side airbag assembly
4. Curtain shield airbag assembly
5. Front seat outer belt assembly
(7) Replace the airbag sensor assemblies and the
airbag assemblies if: 1) damage has occurred
from being dropped, or 2) cracks, dents or other
defects in the case, bracket or connector are
present.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–13
(8) Do not directly expose the airbag sensor
assembly or airbag assembly to hot air or
flames.
(9) Use a voltmeter / ohmmeter with high
impedance (minimum=10 kΩ) for
troubleshooting electrical circuits.
(10)Information labels are attached to the SRS
components. Follow the instructions on the
labels.
(11)After work on the SRS is completed, check the
SRS warning light.
Mark
D030401E10
(b) SPIRAL CABLE
(1) The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the
steering column with the spiral cable at the
neutral position, as cable disconnection and
other problems may occur. Refer to the
information about correct installation of the
steering wheel (See page RS-398).
(c) STEERING PAD
(1) Always place a removed or new steering pad
surface upward as shown in the illustration.
Placing the horn button with the pad surface
facing down could cause a serious accident if
the airbag inflates. Also, do not place anything
on top of the horn button.
Example:
CORRECT
WORNG
D025096E13
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag
squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate,
which could cause serious injury.
Example:
Z013950E02
(3) Grease or detergents of any kind should not be
applied to the horn button.
IN
IN–14
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(4) Store the horn button assembly in an area where
the ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F),
the humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(4 pins). These connectors contain shorting
springs. This feature reduces the possibility of
the airbag deploying due to current entering the
squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of the vehicle or the horn button
assembly by itself, the airbag should be
deployed using SST before disposal (See page
RS-389). Activate the airbag in a safe place
away from electrical noise.
(d) FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always place a removed or new front passenger
airbag assembly with the pad surface facing
upward as shown in the illustration. Placing the
airbag assembly with the airbag inflation
direction facing down could cause a serious
accident if the airbag inflates.
IN
Example:
CORRECT
WRONG
D027522E11
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag
squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate,
which could cause serious injury.
Example:
Z013951E02
(3) Grease or detergents of any kind should not be
applied to the front passenger airbag assembly.
(4) Store the airbag assembly in an area where the
ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F), the
humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–15
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(4 pins). These connectors contain shorting
springs. This feature reduces the possibility of
the airbag deploying due to current entering the
squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of the vehicle or the airbag
assembly unit by itself, the airbag should be
deployed using SST before disposal (See page
RS-405). Activate in a safe place, away from
electrical noise.
(e) FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always place a removed or new front seat side
airbag assembly with the airbag inflation
direction facing up.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag
squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate,
which could cause serious injury.
Example:
D030924E04
(3) Grease or detergents of any kind should not be
applied to the front seat side airbag assembly.
(4) Store the airbag assembly in an area where the
ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F), the
humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(2 pins). These connectors contain shorting
springs. This feature reduces the possibility of
the airbag deploying due to current entering the
squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag
assembly unit by itself, the airbag should be
deployed using SST before disposal (See page
RS-420). Activate in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
IN
IN–16
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(f)
IN
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always place a removed or new curtain shield
airbag assembly in a clear plastic bag, and keep
it in a safe place.
Example:
CORRECT
WRONG
Clear Plastic Bag
D031641E07
CAUTION:
The plastic bag is not reusable.
NOTICE:
Never disassemble the curtain shield airbag
assembly.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag
squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate,
which could cause serious injury.
Example:
D030931E01
(3) Grease or detergents of any kind should not be
applied to the curtain shield airbag assembly.
(4) Store the airbag assembly in an area where the
ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F), the
humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(4 pins). These connectors contain shorting
springs. This feature reduces the possibility of
the airbag deploying due to current entering the
squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag
assembly unit by itself, the airbag should be
deployed using SST before disposal (See page
RS-414). Activate in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–17
(g) FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY AND
REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (SEAT
BELT PRETENSIONER)
(1) Never measure the resistance of the seat outer
belt. This may cause the pretensioner of the seat
belt to activate, which could cause serious injury.
Example:
D030370E03
(2) Never disassemble the seat outer belt.
(3) Never install the seat outer belt on another
vehicle.
(4) Store the seat outer belt in an area where the
ambient temperature is below 80°C (176°F), the
humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(2 pins). These connectors contain shorting
springs. This feature reduces the possibility of
the airbag deploying due to current entering the
squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the seat outer
belt unit by itself, the seat outer belt should be
activated before disposal (See page SB-12).
Activate in a safe place away from electrical
noise.
(7) As the seat outer belt is hot after being activated,
allow some time for it to cool down sufficiently
before disposal. Never apply water to cool down
the seat outer belt.
(8) Grease, detergents, oil or water should not be
applied to the front seat outer belt.
(h) AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(1) Never reuse an airbag sensor assembly that has
been involved in a collision where the SRS has
deployed.
(2) The connectors to the airbag sensor assembly
should be connected or disconnected with the
sensor placed on the floor. If the connectors are
connected or disconnected while the airbag
sensor assembly is not placed on the floor, the
SRS may activate.
IN
IN–18
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(i)
IN
3.
Negative (-)
Cable
Negative (-)
Battery Terminal
D033608E02
INCORRECT
D031751E02
(3) Work must be started at least 90 seconds after
the ignition switch is turned off and the cable is
disconnected from the negative (-) battery
terminal, even if only loosening the set bolts of
the airbag sensor assembly.
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(1) The SRS wire harness is integrated with the
instrument panel wire harness assembly. All the
connectors in the system are a standard yellow
color. If the SRS wire harness becomes
disconnected or the connector becomes broken,
repair or replace it.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL
(a) REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF BATTERY
TERMINAL
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
(1) Before performing electronic work, disconnect
the cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent component and wire damage caused by
accidental short circuits.
(2) When disconnecting the cable, turn the ignition
switch and headlight dimmer switch off and
loosen the cable nut completely. Perform these
operations without twisting or prying the cable.
Then disconnect the cable.
(3) Clock settings, radio settings, audio system
memory, DTCs and other data are erased when
the cable is disconnected from the negative (-)
battery terminal. Write down any necessary data
before disconnecting the cable.
(b) HANDLING OF ELECTRONIC PARTS
(1) Do not open the cover or case of the ECU
unless absolutely necessary. If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be rendered inoperative
by static electricity.
(2) Do not pull the wires when disconnecting
electronic connectors. Pull the connector itself.
(3) Do not drop electronic components, such as
sensors or relays. If they are dropped on a hard
surface, they should be replaced.
(4) When cleaning the engine with steam, protect
the electronic components, air filter and
emission-related components from water.
(5) Never use an impact wrench to remove or install
temperature switches or temperature sensors.
(6) When measuring the resistance between
terminals of a wire connector, insert the tester
probe carefully to prevent terminals from
bending.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
4.
Clamp Track
B107182E01
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF FUEL CONTROL
PARTS
(a) PLACE FOR REMOVING AND INSTALLING FUEL
SYSTEM PARTS
(1) Work in a location with good air ventilation that
does not have welders, grinders, drills, electric
motors, stoves, or any other ignition sources.
(2) Never work in a pit or near a pit as vaporized
fuel will collect in those places.
(b) REMOVING AND INSTALLING FUEL SYSTEM
PARTS
(1) Prepare a fire extinguisher before starting the
operation.
(2) To prevent static electricity, install a ground wire
to the fuel changer, vehicle and fuel tank, do not
spray the surrounding area with water. Be
careful when performing work in this area, as the
work surface will become slippery. Do not clean
up gasoline spills with water, as this may cause
the gasoline to spread, and possibly create a fire
hazard.
(3) Avoid using electric motors, working lights and
other electric equipments that can cause sparks
or high temperatures.
(4) Avoid using iron hammers as they may create
sparks.
(5) Dispose of fuel-contaminated cloth separately
using a fire resistant container.
5.
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF ENGINE INTAKE
PARTS
(a) If any metal particles enter inlet system parts, this
may damage the engine.
(b) When removing and installing inlet system parts,
cover the openings of the removed parts and engine
openings. Use gummed tape or other suitable
materials.
(c) When installing inlet system parts, check that no
metal particles have entered the engine or the
installed parts.
6.
HANDLING OF HOSE CLAMPS
(a) Before removing the hose, check the clamp position
so that it can be reinstalled in the same position.
(b) Replace any deformed or dented clamps with new
ones.
(c) When reusing a hose, attach the clamp on the
clamp track portion of the hose.
(d) For a spring type clamp, you may want to spread
the tabs slightly after installation by pushing in the
direction of the arrows as shown in the illustration.
D001563E01
Spring Type Clamp
IN–19
IN
IN–20
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
7.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE
COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS
(a) Install the antenna far away from the ECU and
sensors of the vehicle electronic systems as
possible.
(b) Install an antenna feeder at least 20 cm (7.87 in.)
away from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle
electronic systems. For details about ECU and
sensors locations, refer to the section on the
applicable components.
(c) Keep the antenna and feeder separate from other
wirings as much as possible. This will prevent
signals sent from the communication equipment
from affecting vehicle equipment and vice-versa.
(d) Check that the antenna and feeder are correctly
adjusted.
(e) Do not install any high-powered mobile
communication system.
8.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH VEHICLE
STABILITY (VSC) SYSTEM
(a) NOTICES WHEN USING DRUM TESTER
(1) Before beginning testing, disable the VSC. To
disable the VSC, turn the engine switch off and
connect SST to terminals TS and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
• Confirm that the VSC warning light blinks.
• VSC system will be reset when the engine
is started.
• For safety, secure the vehicle with
restraint chains while using a wheel
dynamometer.
(b) NOTICES OF RELATED OPERATIONS TO VSC
(1) Do not carry out unnecessary installation and
removal as it might affect the adjustment of VSC
related parts.
(2) Be sure to follow the instructions for work
preparation and final confirmation of proper
operation of the VSC system.
WHEN SERVICING FULL-TIME 4WD VEHICLES
CAUTION:
When servicing or disconnecting the 4WD ECU, be
sure to disconnect all power by removing the 20A
4WD fuse or the negative battery terminal. Failure to
disconnect power for the 4WD ECU before
performing Repair Manual diagnostic procedures
may cause the transfer case actuator to be activated,
resulting in damage to the transfer case actuator.
IN
D029374
DLC3
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
B105749E01
9.
IN–21
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Center Differential Lock Indicator Light
Center Differential
Lock Switch
(a) The Full-time 4WD 4RUNNER is equipped with the
mechanical lock type center differential system.
During tests that require the use of a brake tester or
chassis dynamometer, such as braking force tests
or speedometer tests, if only the front or rear wheels
are to be rotated, it is necessary to set the position
of the center differential to FREE or LOCK
depending on the type of the test being performed.
4WD Switch
D027518E01
Center differential FREE condition
Indicator Light OFF
Condition
Switch OFF
Rotate
Rotate
Center differential
switch
OFF
Indicator light
OFF
4WD switch (H4/L4)
Either
Wheel
A lifted wheel can be
rotated if only one
wheel is lifted up, as
long as transmission is
in N position.
Center differential LOCK condition
Condition
Indicator Light ON
Switch ON
Lock
Lock
D030369E01
Center differential
switch
ON
Indicator light
ON
4WD switch (H4/L4)
Either
Wheel
A lifted wheel cannot be
rotated even if only one
wheel is lifted up, as
long as transmission is
in N position.
NOTICE:
Center differential LOCK ←→ FREE selecting
procedures:
• Operate the switch only when all 4 wheels are
stopped or driving in a straight line.
• Never operate the switch when any wheel is
slipping.
• Never operate the switch when any wheel is
spinning freely.
• Never operate the switch when swerving or
cornering.
IN
IN–22
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Push
IN
4WD Switch
D027517E01
Center Differential Lock Indicator Light
Center Differential
Lock Switch
(1) Refer to HINT below.
HINT:
• Center differential LOCK ←→ FREE
selecting procedures:
Move the vehicle forward or backward slightly
if the indicator light does not operate correctly
when the center differential lock switch is
turned ON or OFF.
• 4WD switch H4 ←→ L4 position switching
procedures:
When switching, always put the shift lever of
the transmission in N position. In other
positions, the transfer gear cannot be
changed.
10. WHEN TESTING BRAKES, SPEEDOMETER, ETC.
(a) When carrying out any kind of servicing or testing
on a Full-time 4WD 4RUNNER in which the front or
rear wheels are to be rotated (braking test,
speedometer test), be sure to observe the
precautions listed below.
Incorrect preparations or test procedures may
cause damage as well as unsuccessful test results.
Before starting any such servicing or test, be sure to
check the following items:
• Center differential mode position (FREE or
LOCK)
4WD Switch
D027518E01
D027519
• Vehicle Stability Control (VSC) system:
If the vehicle is equipped with this system, the
slip indicator light, the VSC/TRAC warning light
and the VSC OFF indicator light come on with
the ignition switch turned ON. They will go off in a
few seconds.
• Whether wheels should be touching the ground
or jacked up
• Transmission gear position (N position)
• 4WD switch position (H4 or L4 position)
• Maximum testing vehicle speed
• Maximum testing time
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
D027513
D027514
D027511
IN–23
(b) Using Braking Tester:
Test by low-speed type brake tester (Vehicle Speed:
Below 0.5 km/h or 0.3 mph) and observe the
following instructions before the test.
(1) Position the wheels to be tested (front or rear)
on the tester.
(2) Put the center differential in FREE position.
(3) Deactivate the Vehicle Stability Control (VSC)
system.
(4) Shift the transmission shift lever to N position.
HINT:
Do not forget to change the Vehicle Stability
Control (VSC) & Traction Control (TRAC)
system to operational condition after the test.
Check that the VSC/TRAC warning indicator
light goes off when restarting the engine.
(c) Using Speedometer Tester:
Observe the following instructions and then test with
the rear wheels.
(1) Position the rear wheels on the tester roller.
(2) Position the front wheels on the free roller or
jack them up.
(3) Put the center differential in FREE position.
(4) Deactivate the Vehicle Stability Control (VSC) &
Traction Control (TRAC) system.
(5) Ensure that the vehicle does not move using
chains.
NOTICE:
The maximum speed should be less than 60
km/h (37 mph) and maximum driving time
should be 1 minute.
HINT:
• Do not suddenly shift gears, brake,
accelerate or decelerate.
• Do not forget to reactivate the Vehicle
Stability Control (VSC) & Traction Control
(TRAC) system. Check that the VSC warning
light goes off when restarting the engine.
(d) Using Chassis Dynamometer:
Observe the following instructions and then test with
the rear wheels.
(1) Remove the front propeller shaft.
(2) Put the center differential in LOCK position.
(3) Deactivate the Vehicle Stability Control (VSC) &
Traction Control (TRAC) system.
(4) Make sure that the vehicle is securely fixed.
HINT:
• Do not suddenly shift gears, brakes,
accelerate or decelerate.
• Do not forget to reactivate the Vehicle
Stability Control (VSC) & Traction Control
(TRAC) system. Check that the VSC warning
indicator light goes off when restarting the
engine.
IN
IN–24
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN
D027512
(e) On-Vehicle Wheel Balancing:
When doing on-vehicle wheel balancing on a fulltime 4WD vehicle, to prevent each wheel from being
rotated at different speed in different directions
(which could damage the center differential), always
be sure to observe the following precautions.
(1) All 4 wheels should be jacked up, so they do not
touch the ground at all.
(2) Put the center differential in LOCK position.
(3) Deactivate the Vehicle Stability Control (VSC) &
Traction Control (TRAC) system.
(4) Fully release the parking brake lever.
(5) None of the brakes should be applied.
(6) Drive the wheels on the wheel balancer with the
engine running.
(7) Carry out the wheel balancing with the
transmission position in D position.
HINT:
• When balancing, pay attention to the other
wheels rotating at the same time.
• Do not suddenly shift gears, brake,
accelerate or decelerate.
• Do not forget to reactivate the Vehicle
Stability Control (VSC) & Traction Control
(TRAC) system to operational condition after
the test. Check that the VSC warning
indicator light goes off when restarting the
engine.
11. FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
CAUTION:
If a large amount of unburned gasoline or gasoline
vapors flow into the converter, it may cause
oveheating and create a fire hazard. To prevent this,
observe the following precautions.
(a) Use only unleaded gasoline.
(b) Avoid prolonged idling.
Avoid idling the engine for more than 20 minutes.
(c) Avoid a spark jump test.
(1) Perform a spark jump test only when absolutely
necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as
possible.
(2) While testing, never race the engine.
(d) Avoid a prolonged engine compression
measurement.
Engine compression measurements must be
performed as rapidly as possible.
(e) Do not run the engine when the fuel tank is nearly
empty. This may cause the engine to misfire and
create an extra load on the converter.
12. WHEN TOWING FULL-TIME 4WD VEHICLES
• Use one of the methods shown below to tow the
vehicle.
IN–25
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
• If the vehicle has trouble with the chassis or drive
train, use method 1 (flat bed truck).
Conditions
Towing Method
Parking Brake
Transmission Shift
Lever Position
IN
1. Flat Bed Truck
Applied
Any Position
Applied
Any Position
2. Wheel Lift Type Truck
From Front
From Rear
D027515E01
NOTICE:
Do not use any towing method other than those
shown above.
• The towing methods shown below are dangerous and
can damage the vehicle, so do not use them.
NO
- Never tow the vehicle using a method in which the wheels that are lifted
up cannot rotate.
- Do not use the sling type towing method either from the front or rear.
- If this towing method is used, either from the front or rear:
NO
(a) The drive train may heat up and be damaged and the wheels may
fly off the dolly.
(b) In addition, if the vehicle is equipped with the VSC & TRAC
system, the system will apply an internal brake to the rotating wheels
when the engine is not shut off.
D027516E01
IN–26
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
13. FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
CAUTION:
If a large amount of unburned gasoline or gasoline
vapors flow into the converter, it may cause
overheating and create a fire hazard. To prevent this,
observe the following precautions.
(a) Use only unleaded gasoline.
(b) Avoid idling the engine for more than 20 minutes.
(c) Avoid performing unnecessary spark jump tests.
(1) Perform a spark jump test only when absolutely
necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as
possible.
(2) While testing, never race the engine.
(d) Avoid a prolonged engine compression
measurement. Engine compression measurements
must be performed as rapidly as possible.
(e) Do not run the engine when the fuel tank is nearly
empty. This may cause the engine to misfire and
create an extra load on the converter.
IN–30
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU
CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
GENERAL INFORMATION
IN
A large number of ECU controlled systems are used in the
4RUNNER. In general, ECU controlled systems are
considered to be very intricate, requiring a high level of
technical knowledge to troubleshoot. However, most problem
checking procedures only involve inspecting the ECU
controlled system's circuits one by one. An adequate
understanding of the system and a basic knowledge of
electricity is enough to perform effective troubleshooting,
accurate diagnoses and necessary repairs.
FOR USING INTELLIGENT TESTER
– Before using the intelligent tester, read the tester
operator's manual thoroughly.
– If the tester cannot communicate with the ECU controlled
systems when the tester is connected to the DLC3 with the
ignition switch on and the tester turned on, there is a
problem on the vehicle side or tester side.
(1)If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the diagnosis
data link line (Bus (+) line) or ECU power circuit of the
vehicle.
(2)If communication is still not possible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably
in the tester itself. Perform the Self Test procedures
outlined in the tester operator's manual.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–31
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1.
1
OPERATION FLOW
HINT:
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the
procedures below. The following is an outline of basic
troubleshooting procedures. Confirm the troubleshooting
procedures for the circuit you are working on before
beginning troubleshooting.
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Ask the customer about the conditions and environment
when the problem occurred.
NEXT
3
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the
battery before proceeding.
NEXT
4
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DTC (AND FREEZE FRAME DATA) CHECK
(a) Visually check the wire harnesses, connectors and fuses
for open and short circuits.
(b) Warm up the engine to the normal operating
temperature.
(c) Confirm the problem symptoms and conditions, and
check for DTCs
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
Go to step 6
IN
IN–32
5
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
DTC CHART
(a) Check the results obtained in step 4. Then find the
output DTC in the DTC chart. Look at the "Trouble Area"
column for a list of potentially malfunctioning circuits and
/ or parts.
IN
NEXT
6
Go to step 7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
(a) Check the results obtained in step 4. Then find the
problem symptoms in the problem symptoms table. Look
at the "Suspected Area" column for a list of potentially
malfunctioning circuits and / or parts.
NEXT
7
CIRCUIT INSPECTION OR PARTS INSPECTION
(a) Identify the malfunctioning circuit or part.
NEXT
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
(a) Adjust, repair or replace the malfunctioning circuit or
parts.
NEXT
9
CONFIRMATION TEST
(a) After the adjustment, repairs or replacement, confirm
that the malfunction no longer exists. If the malfunction
does not reoccur, perform a confirmation test under the
same conditions and in the same environment as when
the malfunction occurred the first time.
NEXT
END
2.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
IN–33
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
HINT:
• In troubleshooting, confirm that the problem symptoms
have been accurately identified. Preconceptions should be
discarded in order to make an accurate judgment. To
clearly understand what the problem symptoms are, it is
extremely important to ask the customer about the
problem and the conditions at the time the malfunction
occurred.
• Gather as much information as possible for reference.
Past problems that seem unrelated may also help in some
cases.
• The following 5 items are important points in the problem
analysis:
What
Vehicle model, system name
When
Date, time, occurrence frequency
Where
Road conditions
Under what conditions?
Running conditions, driving conditions, weather conditions
How did it happen?
Problem symptoms
3.
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
HINT:
The diagnostic system in the 4RUNNER has various
functions.
• The first function is the Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC) check. A DTC is a code stored in the ECU
memory whenever a malfunction in the signal circuits
to the ECU occurs. In a DTC check, a previous
malfunction's DTC can be checked by a technician
during troubleshooting.
• Another function is the Input Signal Check, which
checks if the signals from various switches are sent to
the ECU correctly.
By using these functions, the problem areas can be
narrowed down and troubleshooting is more effective.
Diagnostic functions are incorporated in the following
system in the 4RUNNER.
System
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Check
Input Signal Check
(Sensor Check)
Diagnostic Test Mode
(Active Test)
SFI System (1GR-FE)
{
(with Check Mode)
{
{
SFI System (2UZ-FE)
{
(with Check Mode)
{
{
Tire Pressure Warning System
{
{
{
Rear Air Suspension System
{
{
{
{
ABS with EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC System
{
{
Electronically Controlled Automatic Transmission [ECT]
(1GR-FE)
{
(with Check Mode)
{
Electronically Controlled Automatic Transmission [ECT]
(2UZ-FE)
{
(with Check Mode)
{
Air Conditioning System
{
{
Cruise Control System
{
{
IN
IN–34
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
• In the DTC check, it is very important to determine
whether the problem indicated by the DTC either: 1)
still occurs, or 2) occurred in the past but has returned
to normal. In addition, the DTC should be compared
to the problem symptom to see if they are related. For
this reason, DTCs should be checked before and after
confirmation of symptoms (i.e., whether or not
problem symptoms exist) to determine current system
conditions, as shown in the flowchart below.
• Never skip the DTC check. Failing to check DTCs
may, depending on the case, result in unnecessary
troubleshooting for systems operating normally or
lead to repairs not related to the problem. Follow the
procedures listed in the flowchart in the correct order.
• The following flowchart shows how to proceed with
troubleshooting using the DTC check. Directions from
the flowchart will indicate how to proceed either to
DTC troubleshooting or to the troubleshooting of each
problem symptom.
IN
1
DTC CHECK
NEXT
2
MAKE A NOTE OF DTCS DISPLAYED AND THEN CLEAR MEMORY
NEXT
3
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
No symptoms exist
A
Symptoms exist
B
B
Go to step 5
A
4
SIMULATION TEST USING SYMPTOM SIMULATION METHODS
NEXT
5
DTC CHECK
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
B
B
IN–35
TROUBLESHOOTING OF PROBLEM
INDICATED BY DTC
IN
A
6
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
No symptoms exist
A
Symptoms exist
B
If a DTC was displayed in the initial DTC check, the
problem may have occurred in a wire harness or
connector in that circuit in the past. Check the wire
harness and connectors.
B
SYSTEM NORMAL
A
TROUBLESHOOTING OF EACH PROBLEM SYMPTOM
The problem still occurs in a place other than the diagnostic
circuit (the DTC displayed first is either for a past problem or
a secondary problem).
4. SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no
problem symptoms occur. In such a case, a thorough
problem analysis must be carried out. A simulation of the
same or similar conditions and environment in which the
problem occurred in the customer's vehicle should be
carried out. No matter how much skill or experience a
technician has, troubleshooting without confirming the
problem symptoms will lead to important repairs being
overlooked and mistakes or delays.
For example:
With a problem that only occurs when the engine is
cold or as a result of vibration caused by the road
during driving, the problem can never be
determined if the symptoms are being checked on
a stationary vehicle or a vehicle with a warmed-up
engine. Vibration, heat or water penetration
(moisture) is difficult to reproduce. The symptom
simulation tests below are effective substitutes for
the conditions and can be applied on a stationary
vehicle. Important points in the symptom
simulation test:
IN–36
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
In the symptom simulation test, the problem
symptoms as well as the problem area or parts
must be confirmed. First, narrow down the
possible problem circuits according to the
symptoms. Then, connect the tester and carry out
the symptom simulation test, judging whether the
circuit being tested is defective or normal. Also,
confirm the problem symptoms at the same time.
Refer to the problem symptoms table for each
system to narrow down the possible causes.
IN
Vibrate Slightly
Shake Slightly
Vibrate Slightly
B071602E03
D025085E02
(a) VIBRATION METHOD: When a malfunction seems
to occur as a result of vibration.
(1) PART AND SENSOR
Apply slight vibration with a finger to the part of
the sensor suspected to be the cause of the
problem, and check whether or not the
malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
Applying strong vibration to relays may open
relays.
(2) CONNECTORS
Slightly shake the connector vertically and
horizontally.
(3) WIRE HARNESS
Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and
horizontally.
HINT:
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration
are the major areas that should be checked
thoroughly.
(b) HEAT METHOD: When a malfunction seems to
occur when the area in question is heated.
(1) Heat the component that is the possible cause of
the malfunction with a hair dryer or similar
device. Check if the malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
• Do not heat to more than 60°C (140°F).
Exceeding this temperature may damage
the components.
• Do not apply heat directly to the parts in
the ECU.
(c) WATER SPRINKLING METHOD: When a
malfunction seems to occur on a rainy day or in
high-humidity.
(1) Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check if the
malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
• Never sprinkle water directly into the
engine compartment. Indirectly change
the temperature and humidity by spraying
water onto the front of the radiator.
• Never apply water directly onto the
electronic components.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–37
HINT:
If the vehicle has or had a water leakage
problem, the leakage may have damaged the
ECU or connections. Look for evidence of
corrosion or short circuits. Proceed with caution
during water tests.
AUTO
B107149
(d) HIGH ELECTRICAL LOAD METHOD: When a
malfunction seems to occur when electrical load is
excessive.
(1) Turn on the heater blower, headlight, rear
window defogger and all other electrical loads.
Check if the malfunction reoccurs.
5. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Look for output Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) (from the
DTC checks) in the appropriate section's Diagnostic Trouble
Code Chart. Use the chart to determine the trouble area and
the proper inspection procedure. A description of each of the
chart's columns is shown in the table below.
Item
Description
DTC No.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code
Detection Item
Indicates the system or details of the problem
Trouble Area
Indicates the suspect areas of the problem
See Page
Indicates the page where the inspection procedures for each circuit is
to be found, or gives instruction for checking and repairs.
6.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
When a "Normal" code is output during a DTC check but
the problem still occurs, use the Problem Symptoms
Table. The suspected areas (circuits or parts) for each
problem symptoms are in the table. The suspected areas
are listed in order of probability. A description of each of
the chart's columns is shown in the table below.
HINT:
In some cases, the problem is not detected by the
diagnostic system even though a problem symptom
occurs. It is possible that the problem is occurring
outside the detection range of the diagnostic system, or
that the problem occurs in a completely different system.
Item
Description
Problem Symptom
-
Circuit Inspection, Inspection Order
Indicates the order in which the circuits need to be checked
Circuit or Part Name
Indicates the circuit or part which needs to be checked
See Page
Indicates the page where the flowchart for each circuit is located
7.
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
A description of the main areas of each circuit inspection
is shown in the table below.
Item
Description
Circuit Description
The major role, operation of the circuit and its component parts are
explained.
Diagnostic Trouble Code No. and Detection item
Indicates the diagnostic trouble codes, diagnostic trouble code
settings and suspected areas for a problem
IN
IN–38
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Item
Description
Wiring diagram
This shows a wiring diagram of the circuit.
Use this diagram together with ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM to
thoroughly understand the circuit.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code. B = Black, L = Blue,
R = Red, BR = Brown, LG = Light Green, V = Violet, G = Green, O =
Orange, W = White, GR = Gray, P = Pink, Y = Yellow, SB = Sky Blue
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter
indicates the color of the stripe.
Inspection Procedures
Use the inspection procedures to determine if the circuit is normal or
abnormal. If abnormal, use the inspection procedures to determine
whether the problem is located in the sensors, actuators, wire
harnesses or ECU.
Indicates the condition of the connector of the ECU during the check
Connector being checked is connected.
Connections of tester are indicated by (+) or (-) after the terminal
name.
Connector being checked is disconnected.
The inspections between a connector and body ground, information
about the body ground is not shown in the illustration.
IN
IN–43
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN MANUAL
Abbreviations
Meaning
ABS
Anti-Lock Brake System
A/C
Air Conditioner
AC
Alternating Current
ACC
Accessory
ACIS
Acoustic Control Induction System
ACM
Active Control Engine Mount
ACSD
Automatic Cold Start Device
A.D.D
Automatic Disconnecting Differential
A/F
Air-Fuel Ratio
AHC
Active Height Control Suspension
ALR
Automatic Locking Retractor
ALT
Alternator
AMP
Amplifier
ANT
Antenna
APPROX.
Approximately
ASSY
Assembly
A/T, ATM
Automatic Transmission (Transaxle)
ATF
Automatic Transmission Fluid
AUTO
Automatic
AUX
Auxiliary
AVG
Average
AVS
Adaptive Variable Suspension
AWD
All Wheel Drive Vehicle
B+
Battery Voltage
BA
Brake Assist
BACS
Boost Altitude Compensation System
BAT
Battery
BDC
Bottom Dead Center
B/L
Bi-Level
B/S
Bore-Stroke Ratio
BTDC
Before Top Dead Center
BVSV
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve
CAN
Controller Area Network
CB
Circuit Breaker
CCo
Catalytic Converter For Oxidation
CCV
Canister Closed Valve
CD
Compact Disc
CF
Cornering Force
CG
Center Of Gravity
CH
Channel
CKD
Complete Knock Down
COMB.
Combination
CPE
Coupe
CPS
Combustion Pressure Sensor
CPU
Central Processing Unit
CRS
Child Restraint System
IN
IN–44
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
Abbreviations
CTR
IN
Meaning
Center
C/V
Check Valve
CV
Control Valve
CW
Curb Weight
DC
Direct Current
DEF
Defogger
DFL
Deflector
DIFF.
Differential
DIFF. LOCK
Differential Lock
D/INJ
Direct Injection
DLC
Data Link Connector
DLI
Distributorless Ignition
DOHC
Double Overhead Camshaft
DP
Dash Pot
DS
Dead Soak
DSP
Digital Signal Processor
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
DVD
Digital Versatile Disc
EBD
Electric Brake Force Distribution
EC
Electrochromic
ECAM
Engine Control And Measurement System
ECD
Electronically Controlled Diesel
ECDY
Eddy Current Dynamometer
ECT
Electronic Controlled Automatic Transmission
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
ED
Electro-Deposited Coating
EDU
Electronic Driving Unit
EDIC
Electric Diesel Injection Control
EFI
Electronic Fuel Injection
E/G
Engine
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
EGR-VM
EGR-Vacuum Modulator
ELR
Emergency Locking Retractor
EPS
Electric Power Steering
ENG
Engine
ES
Easy & Smooth
ESA
Electronic Spark Advance
ETCS-i
Electronic Throttle Control System-intelligent
EVAP
Evaporative Emission Control
EVP
Evaporator
E-VRV
Electric Vacuum Regulating Valve
EX
Exhaust
FE
Fuel Economy
FF
Front-Engine-Front-Wheel-Drive
F/G
Fuel Gauge
FIPG
Formed In Place Gasket
FL
Fusible Link
F/P
Fuel Pump
FPU
Fuel Pressure Up
IN–45
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
Abbreviations
FR
Meaning
Front
F/W
Flywheel
FW/D
Flywheel Damper
FWD
Front-Wheel-Drive
GAS
Gasoline
GND
Ground
GPS
Global Positioning System
GSA
Gear Shift Actuator
HAC
High Altitude Compensator
H/B
Hatchback
H-FUSE
High Current Fuse
HI
High
HID
High Intensity Discharge (Headlight)
HPU
Hydraulic Power Unit
HSG
Housing
HT
Hard Top
HV
Hybrid Vehicle
HWS
Heated Windshield System
IC
Integrated Circuit
IDI
Indirect Diesel Injection
IFS
Independent Front Suspension
IG
Ignition
IIA
Integrated Ignition Assembly
IN
Intake (Manifold, Valve)
INT
Intermittent
I/P
Instrument Panel
IRS
Independent Rear Suspension
ISC
Idle Speed Control
J/B
Junction Block
J/C
Junction Connector
KD
Kick-Down
LAN
Local Area Network
LB
Liftback
LCD
Liquid Crystal Display
LED
Light Emitting Diode
LH
Left-Hand
LHD
Left-Hand Drive
LIN
Local Interconnect Network
L/H/W
Length, Height, Width
LLC
Long-Life Coolant
LNG
Liquefied Natural Gas
LO
Low
LPG
Liquefied Petroleum Gas
LSD
Limited Slip Differential
LSP & BV
Load Sensing Proportioning and Bypass Valve
LSPV
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX.
Maximum
MIC
Microphone
IN
IN–46
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
Abbreviations
MIL
IN
Meaning
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
MIN.
Minimum
MG1
Motor Generator No. 1
MG2
Motor Generator No. 2
MMT
Multi-mode Manual Transmission
MP
Multipurpose
MPI
Multipoint Electronic Injection
MPX
Multiplex Communication System
M/T, MTM
Manual Transmission (Transaxle)
MT
Mount
MTG
Mounting
N
Neutral
NA
Natural Aspiration
NO.
Number
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
OC
Oxidation Catalyst
OCV
Oil Control Valve
O/D
Overdrive
OEM
Original Equipment Manufacturing
OHC
Overhead Camshaft
OHV
Overhead Valve
OPT
Option
ORVR
On-board Refilling Vapor Recovery
O/S
Oversize
P & BV
Proportioning and Bypass Valve
PBD
Power Back Door
PCS
Power Control System
PCV
Positive Crankcase Ventilation
PKB
Parking Brake
PPS
Progressive Power Steering
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
PS
Power Steering
PSD
Power Slide Door
PTC
Positive Temperature Coefficient
PTO
Power Take-Off
PZEV
Partial Zero Emission Vehicle
P/W
Power Window
R&P
Rack and Pinion
RAM
Random Access Memory
R/B
Relay Block
RBS
Recirculating Ball Type Steering
REAS
Relative Absorber System
R/F
Reinforcement
RFS
Rigid Front Suspension
RH
Right-Hand
RHD
Right-Hand Drive
RLY
Relay
ROM
Read Only Memory
RR
Rear
IN–47
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
Abbreviations
Meaning
RRS
Rigid Rear Suspension
RSE
Rear Seat Entertainment
RWD
Rear-Wheel Drive
SC
Supercharger
SCV
Swirl Control Valve
SDN
Sedan
SEN
Sensor
SICS
Starting Injection Control System
SOC
State Of Charge
SOHC
Single Overhead Camshaft
SPEC
Specification
SPI
Single Point Injection
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
STD
Standard
STJ
Cold-Start Fuel Injection
SW
Switch
SYS
System
T/A
Transaxle
TACH
Tachometer
TBI
Throttle Body Electronic Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
TCCS
TOYOTA Computer-Controlled System
TCV
Timing Control Valve
TDC
Top Dead Center
TEMP.
Temperature
TFT
TOYOTA Free-Tronic
TIS
Total Information System For Vehicle Development
T/M
Transmission
TMC
TOYOTA Motor Corporation
TMMIN
PT. TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Indonesia
TMMK
TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Kentucky, Inc.
TMT
TOYOTA Motor Thailand Co. Ltd.
TRAC/TRC
Traction Control System
TURBO
Turbocharge
TWC
Three-Way Catalyst
U/D
Underdrive
U/S
Undersize
VCV
Vacuum Control Valve
VDIM
Vehicle Dynamics Integrated Management
VENT
Ventilator
VIM
Vehicle Interface Module
VGRS
Variable Gear Ratio Steering
VIN
Vehicle Identification Number
VPS
Variable Power Steering
VSC
Vehicle Skid Control
VSV
Vacuum Switching Valve
VTV
Vacuum Transmitting Valve
IN
IN–48
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
Abbreviations
VVT-i
IN
Meaning
Variable Valve Timing-intelligent
W/
With
WGN
Wagon
W/H
Wire Harness
W/O
Without
1ST
First
2ND
Second
2WD
Two Wheel Drive Vehicle (4 x 2)
3RD
Third
4TH
Fourth
4WD
Four Wheel Drive Vehicle (4 x 4)
4WS
Four Wheel Steering System
5TH
Fifth
PP–6
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09031-00040
Pin Punch .
09040-00011
Hexagon Wrench Set
PP
(09043-20050)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 5
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
(09043-20080)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
(09043-20100)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
(09043-30140)
Straight Hexagon Wrench 14
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09043-50100
Bi-hexagon Wrench 10 mm
09200-00010
Engine Adjust Kit
09904-00010
Expander Set
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PP–7
EQUIPMENT
Alignment tester
Angle gauge
Bar
CO/HC meter
Compression gauge
Connecting rod aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Engine Sling Device
Feeler gauge
Heater
Micrometer
OBD II scan tool
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Radiator cap tester
Reamer
Slide calipers
Spring tester
Steel square
Tachometer
Timing light
Tire pressure gauge
Toe-in gauge
Torque wrench
Valve seat cutter
V-block
Vernier calipers
Wooden block
Press
PP
PP–8
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B or
Equivalent
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
PP
PP–12
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09031-00040
Pin Punch .
09040-00011
Hexagon Wrench Set
PP
(09043-20050)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 5
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
(09043-20080)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
(09043-20100)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
(09043-30140)
Straight Hexagon Wrench 14
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09043-50100
Bi-hexagon Wrench 10 mm
09200-00010
Engine Adjust Kit
09904-00010
Expander Set
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PP–13
EQUIPMENT
Alignment tester
Angle gauge
Bar
CO/HC meter
Compression gauge
Connecting rod aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Engine Sling Device
Feeler gauge
Heater
Micrometer
OBD II scan tool
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Radiator cap tester
Reamer
Slide calipers
Spring tester
Steel square
Tachometer
Timing light
Tire pressure gauge
Toe-in gauge
Torque wrench
Valve seat cutter
V-block
Vernier calipers
Wooden block
Press
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PP–1
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–2
EQUIPMENT
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
Ohmmeter
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PP–14
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B or
Equivalent
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
PP
PP–2
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PP–3
EQUIPMENT
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
Ohmmeter
PP
PP–16
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE FUEL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
Hexagon Wrench Set
(09043-20080)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PP
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE FUEL
PP–17
EQUIPMENT
Clip
Measuring Flask
Ohmmeter
Radiator cap tester
Service Wire Harness
Stopwatch
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PP–3
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION
SST
09032-00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
09201-01055
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 5.5
09201-10000
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer Set
09201-41020
Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
09202-70020
Valve Spring Compressor
(09202-00010)
09213-54015
(91651-60855)
Attachment
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
Bolt
09222-30010
Connecting Rod Bushing Remover
& Replacer
09223-78010
Crankshaft Oil Seal Replacer
09226-10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
PP
PP–4
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
09843-18030
Tacho-pulse Pickup Wire No. 2
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No. 2
09950-50013
Puller C Set
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-05030)
Claw No.3
PP
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
(09951-00350)
Replacer 35
09950-70010
Handle Set
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
(09951-07150)
Handle 150
PP–5
PP
09992-00500
Compression Gauge Attachment
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE FUEL
PP–19
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-20080)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
PP
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP–20
EQUIPMENT
Clip
Measuring Flask
Ohmmeter
Radiator cap tester
Service Wire Harness
PP
Stopwatch
Torque wrench
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE FUEL
PP–8
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09032-00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
09201-01055
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 5.5
09201-10000
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer Set
(09201-01060)
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 6
09201-41020
Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
09202-70020
Valve Spring Compressor
(09202-00010)
Attachment
(09202-01010)
Arm
09213-70011
Crankshaft Pully Holding Tool
(09213-70020)
Bolt
(90105-08076)
Bolt
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
09222-30010
Connecting Rod Bushing Remover
& Replacer
09223-46011
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
PP–9
PP
09223-56010
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Replacer
09316-60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316-00011)
Replacer Pipe
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
09843-18030
Tacho-pulse Pickup Wire No.2
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
09950-50013
Puller C Set
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
(09953-05010)
Center Bolt 100
PP–10
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-05010)
Claw No.1
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
PP
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00240)
Replacer 24
(09951-00300)
Replacer 30
(09951-00350)
Replacer 35
(09951-00440)
Replacer 44
(09952-06010)
Adapter
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
09960-10010
Variable Pin Wrench Set
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly
(09963-00350)
Pin 3.5
PP–11
PP
(09963-00500)
Pin 5
PP–14
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE FUEL
1GR-FE FUEL
PREPARATION
SST
09268-31011
PP
Injection Measuring Tool Set
(90467-13001)
Clip
(95336-08070)
Hose
09268-41047
Injection Measuring Tool Set
(09268-41091)
NO.7 Union
(95336-08070)
Hose
09268-41140
Adapter
09268-41400
Clamp
09268-45014
EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
(09268-41200)
Gauge
(09268-41220)
Hose
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE FUEL
(09268-41250)
T Joint
(90467-13001)
Clip
PP–15
PP
09808-14020
Retainer Tool, Fuel Pump
(09808-01410)
Holder
(09808-01420)
Claw
(09808-01430)
Bolt
09842-30080
Wire H EFI Inspection
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE FUEL
PP–17
2UZ-FE FUEL
PREPARATION
SST
09268-31011
Injection Measuring Tool Set
(09268-41091)
NO.7 Union
(09268-41110)
Adaptor
(09268-41300)
Clamp
(95336-08070)
Hose
09268-45014
EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
(09268-41190)
Adapter
(09268-41200)
Gauge
(09268-41210)
Hose
(90405-06167)
I Union
(90467-11009)
Clip
PP
PP–18
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE FUEL
09808-14020
Retainer Tool,Fuel Pump
(09808-01410)
Holder
(09808-01430)
Bolt
PP
09842-30070
Wire F EFI Inspection
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL
PP–19
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–20
EQUIPMENT
Service Wire Harness
Ohmmeter
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
Intelligent vacuum pump
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL
PP–20
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
PP–21
EQUIPMENT
Service Wire Harness
Ohmmeter
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
Intelligent vacuum pump
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE INTAKE
PP–21
1GR-FE INTAKE
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–22
EQUIPMENT
Ohmmeter
Intelligent vacuum pump
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE INTAKE
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
PP–29
EQUIPMENT
Alignment tester
Angle gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Feeler gauge
Precision straight edge
Radiator cap tester
Tire pressure gauge
Toe-in gauge
Torque wrench
Wooden block
CO/HC meter
Straight edge
Press
PP
PP–30
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Oil grade
-
Classification
API grade SL or SJ, Energy-Conserving or
ILSAC, multi-grade engine oil
Drain and refill
PP
Dry fill
w/ oil filter change
5.2 liters (5.5 US qts, 4.6 lmp. qts)
-
w/o oil filter change
4.9 liters (5.2 US qts, 4.3 lmp. qts)
-
6.0 liters (6.3 US qts, 5.3 lmp. qts)
-
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
PP–31
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B or
Equivalent
PP
PP–22
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE INTAKE
2UZ-FE INTAKE
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE INTAKE
PP–23
EQUIPMENT
Ohmmeter
Intelligent vacuum pump
PP
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
PP–31
EQUIPMENT
Alignment tester
Angle gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Feeler gauge
Precision straight edge
Radiator cap tester
Tire pressure gauge
Toe-in gauge
Torque wrench
Wooden block
CO/HC meter
Straight edge
Press
PP
PP–32
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Oil grade
-
Classification
API grade SL or SJ, Energy-Conserving or
ILSAC, multi-grade engine oil
Drain and refill
PP
Dry fill
w/ oil filter change
6.2 liters (6.5 US qts, 5.5 lmp. qts)
-
w/o oil filter change
5.7 liters (6.0 US qts, 5.0 lmp. qts)
-
7.1 liters (7.5 US qts, 6.2 lmp. qts)
-
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE EXHAUST
PP–23
1GR-FE EXHAUST
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Vernier calipers
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
PP–33
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
PP
PP–24
2UZ-FE EXHAUST
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Vernier calipers
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE EXHAUST
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE COOLING
PP–25
1GR-FE COOLING
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Heater
Radiator cap tester
Slide calipers
Thermometer
Torque wrench
PP
PP–26
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE COOLING
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant
PP
Capacity
9.8 liters (10.4 US qts, 8.6 lmp. qts)
Classification
"Toyota Super Long Life Coolant" or similar
high quality ethylene glycol based nonsilicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and nonborate coolant with long-life hybrid organic
acid technology
PP–26
2UZ-FE COOLING
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Heater
Radiator cap tester
Slide calipers
PP
Thermometer
Torque wrench
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE COOLING
PP–27
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE COOLING
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant
Capacity
12.3 liters (13.0 US qts, 10.8 lmp. qts)
Classification
"Toyota Super Long Life Coolant" or similar
high quality ethylene glycol based nonsilicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and nonborate coolant with long-life hybrid organic
acid technology
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
PP–27
1GR-FE LUBRICATION
PREPARATION
SST
09226-10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
09228-07501
Oil Filter Wrench
PP
PP–28
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-20080)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
PP
09042-00010
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Torx Socket T30
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
PP–29
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
PREPARATION
SST
09228-07501
Oil Filter Wrench
PP
PP–30
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-20060)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
PP
09904-00010
Expander Set
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE IGNITION
PP–31
1GR-FE IGNITION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–32
EQUIPMENT
Spark plug cleaner
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE IGNITION
PP–32
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE IGNITION
2UZ-FE IGNITION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
09200-00010
(09857-00031)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
Engine Adjust Kit
Spark Plug Gap Gauge
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE IGNITION
PP–33
EQUIPMENT
Spark plug cleaner
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE STARTING
PP–33
1GR-FE STARTING
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09904-00010
(09904-00050)
Expander Set
No. 4 Claw
PP
PP–34
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter (A)
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Ohmmeter
Pull scale
Service Wire Harness
PP
Torque wrench
V-block
Vernier calipers
Dial indicator
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE STARTING
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE CHARGING
PP–37
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–38
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter (A)
Ohmmeter
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
V-block
PP
Vernier calipers
Press
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE CHARGING
PP–40
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter (A)
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Ohmmeter
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
PP
V-block
Vernier calipers
Press
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE CHARGING
PP–34
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE STARTING
2UZ-FE STARTING
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE STARTING
PP–35
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter (A)
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Ohmmeter
Pull scale
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
V-block
Vernier calipers
Dial indicator
PP
PREPARATION – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
PP–43
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-20100)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
PP
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
PP–44
PREPARATION – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
EQUIPMENT
Straight edge
Vernier calipers
Torque converter
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Drive plate
Punch
Torque wrench
PP
Torque converter
PP–60
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
09031-00030
Pin Punch
09044-00020
Torx Socket E10
09905-00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
09905-00013
Snap Ring Pliers
PP
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
PP–61
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Micrometer
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
Press
PP
PP–62
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Classification
Front differential oil
1.40 +- 0.05 liters
(1.48 +- 0.05 US qts, 1.23 +- 0.04 lmp. qts)
Hypoid gear oil APL GL-5
Above - 18°C (0 °F): SAE 90
Below - 18°C (0 °F): SAE 80W or 80W - 90
Rear differential oil
3.05 +- 0.05 liters
(3.22 +- 0.05 US qts, 2.68 +- 0.04 lmp. qts)
Hypoid gear oil APL GL-5
Above - 18°C (0 °F): SAE 90
Below - 18°C (0 °F): SAE 80W or 80W - 90
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE CHARGING
PP–35
1GR-FE CHARGING
PREPARATION
SST
09285-76010
Injection Pump Camshaft Bearing
Cone Replacer
09820-00021
Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
09820-00031
Alternator Rotor Rear Bearing
Replacer
09820-63010
Alternator Pulley Set Nut Wrench
Set
(09820-06010)
Alternator Rotor Shaft Wrench
(09820-06020)
Alternator Pulley Set Nut 22 mm
Wrench
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
PP
PP–36
PREPARATION – 1GR-FE CHARGING
(09955-04071)
Claw No.7
(09957-04010)
Attachment
(09958-04011)
Holder
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
(09951-00470)
Replacer 47
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PP
PP–45
PREPARATION – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
Automatic transmission fluid
Refer to "AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
FLUID"
TOYOTA GENUINE ATF WS
PP
PP–38
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE CHARGING
2UZ-FE CHARGING
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09285-76010
Injection Pump Camshaft Bearing
Cone Replacer
09820-00021
Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
09820-00031
Alternator Rotor Rear Bearing
Replacer
09820-63011
Alternator Pulley Set Nut
Wrench Set
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
(09955-04071)
Claw No.7
(09957-04010)
Attachment
PREPARATION – 2UZ-FE CHARGING
(09958-04011)
Holder
09950-60010
Replacer Set
PP–39
PP
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
(09951-00470)
Replacer 47
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PP–46
PREPARATION – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-20100)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
PP
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
PP–47
EQUIPMENT
Straight edge
Torque converter
Vernier calipers
Torque converter
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Drive plate
Punch
Torque wrench
PP
PP–40
PREPARATION – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09023-12701
Union Nut Wrench 17mm
09223-15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
09316-60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316-00011)
Replacer Pipe
(09316-00051)
Replacer D
09320-89010
Transfer Clutch Spring
Compressor
09350-30020
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09350-07020)
Oil Pump Puller
(09350-07040)
No.2 Piston Spring Compressor
(09350-07050)
No.3 Piston Spring Compressor
PREPARATION – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
(09350-07060)
No.1 Snap Ring Expander
(09350-07070)
No.2 Snap Ring Expander
PP–41
PP
(09350-07080)
Brake Reaction Sleeve Puller
(09350-07090)
Brake No.1 Piston Puller
(09350-07110)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351-32140)
Oil Seal Replacer
09350-32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351-32010)
One-way Clutch Test Tool
(09351-32020)
Stator Stopper
09351-40010
Tool Set, TOYOTA Automatic
Transmission
09387-00070
First & Reverse Brake Wrench
09710-30050
Suspension Arm Bushing Replacer
PP–42
PREPARATION – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PP
09992-00095
Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
(09992-00231)
Adaptor C
(09992-00271)
Gauge Assy
PP–48
PREPARATION – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Classification
Automatic transmission fluid
Refer to "AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
FLUID"
TOYOTA GENUINE ATF WS
PP–44
PREPARATION – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09023-12701
Union Nut Wrench 17mm
09226-10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
09320-89010
Transfer Clutch Spring
Compressor
09350-30020
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09350-07020)
Oil Pump Puller
(09350-07040)
No.2 Piston Spring Compressor
(09350-07050)
No.3 Piston Spring Compressor
(09350-07060)
No.1 Snap Ring Expander
(09350-07070)
No.2 Snap Ring Expander
(09350-07080)
Brake Reaction Sleeve Puller
(09350-07090)
Brake No.1 Piston Puller
PREPARATION – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
(09350-07110)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351-32140)
Oil Seal Replacer
PP–45
PP
09350-32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351-32010)
One-way Clutch Test Tool
(09351-32020)
Stator Stopper
09351-40010
Tool Set, TOYOTA Automatic
Transmission
09387-00070
First & Reverse Brake Wrench
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
09992-00095
Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
(09992-00231)
Adaptor C
(09992-00271)
Gauge Assy
PP–50
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Micrometer
Torque wrench
Plastic hammer
Vernier calipers
PP
PREPARATION – VF4AM TRANSFER
PP–51
PREPARATION – VF4AM TRANSFER
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Transfer oil
1.4 liters (1.5 US qts, 1.2 lmp. qts)
Classification
API GL-5
SAE 75W-90
PP
PREPARATION – VF4AM TRANSFER
PP–47
VF4AM TRANSFER
PREPARATION
SST
09223-15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09223-46011
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
09316-60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316-00011)
Replacer Pipe
(09316-00031)
Replacer B
(09316-00071)
Replacer F
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
09515-30010
Rear Wheel Bearing Replacer
09554-30011
Differential Oil Seal Replacer
09555-55010
Differential Drive Pinion
Bearing Replacer
PP
PP–48
PREPARATION – VF4AM TRANSFER
09612-65014
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
(09612-01030)
Claw C
(09612-01050)
Hanger Pin with Nut
PP
09631-32020
Seal Ring Tool
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04030)
Center Bolt 200
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
(09955-04051)
Claw No.5
(09957-04010)
Attachment
(09958-04011)
Holder
PREPARATION – VF4AM TRANSFER
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00320)
Replacer 32
PP–49
PP
(09951-00570)
Replacer 57
(09951-00590)
Replacer 59
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PP–52
PREPARATION – VF4AM TRANSFER
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281, Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
PP
PP–50
PREPARATION – VF4BM TRANSFER
VF4BM TRANSFER
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09223-15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09223-46011
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
09316-60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316-00011)
Replacer Pipe
(09316-00031)
Replacer B
(09316-00071)
Replacer F
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
09515-30010
Rear Wheel Bearing Replacer
09554-30011
Differential Oil Seal Replacer
09555-55010
Differential Drive Pinion
Bearing Replacer
PREPARATION – VF4BM TRANSFER
09612-65014
(09612-01030)
PP–51
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
Claw C
PP
(09612-01050)
Hanger Pin with Nut
09631-32020
Seal Ring Tool
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04030)
Center Bolt 200
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
(09955-04051)
Claw No.5
(09957-04010)
Attachment
(09958-04011)
Holder
PP–52
PREPARATION – VF4BM TRANSFER
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00320)
Replacer 32
(09951-00570)
Replacer 57
(09951-00590)
Replacer 59
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PP
PREPARATION – VF4BM TRANSFER
PP–53
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Micrometer
Torque wrench
Plastic hammer
Vernier calipers
PP
PP–54
PREPARATION – VF4BM TRANSFER
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Transfer oil
1.4 liters (1.5 US qts, 1.2 lmp. qts)
Classification
API GL-5
SAE 75W-90
PREPARATION – PROPELLER SHAFT
PP–53
PROPELLER SHAFT
PREPARATION
SST
09325-40010
Transmission Oil Plug
09332-25010
Propeller Shaft Center Bearing
Replacer
09636-20010
Upper Ball Joint Dust Cover
Replacer
PP
PP–54
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Spring tension gauge
PP
PREPARATION – PROPELLER SHAFT
PREPARATION – VF4BM TRANSFER
PP–55
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281, Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
PP
PP–54
PREPARATION – DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09240-00020
Wire Gauge Set
09520-01010
Drive Shaft Remover Attachment
09520-24010
Differential Side Gear Shaft
Puller
(09520-32040)
Shocker Set
09521-24010
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
09527-10011
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
09628-62011
Boll Joint Puller
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
PREPARATION – DRIVE SHAFT
PP–55
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09905-00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
PP
PP–56
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – DRIVE SHAFT
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
PP–55
DIFFERENTIAL
PREPARATION
SST
09223-00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
09223-15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09226-10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
09308-10010
Oil Seal Puller
09316-60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316-00011)
Replacer Pipe
(09316-00021)
Replacer A
(09316-00051)
Replacer D
09330-00021
(09330-00030)
Companion Flange Holding Tool
Pin
PP
PP–56
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
09350-20015
(09369-20040)
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
Piston Spring Compressor Set
PP
09502-12010
Differential Bearing Replacer
09504-00011
Differential Side Bearing
Adjusting Nut Wrench
09506-30012
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Cone Replacer
09554-22010
Differential Oil Seal Replacer
09554-30011
Differential Oil Seal Replacer
09556-22010
Drive Pinion Front Bearing
Remover
09564-32011
Differential Preload Adaptor
09608-32010
Steering Knuckle Oil Seal
Replacer
09612-65014
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
(09612-01020)
Claw B
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
(09612-01050)
09636-20010
PP–57
Hanger Pin with Nut
Upper Ball Joint Dust Cover
Replacer
PP
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
(09951-00680)
Replacer 68
(09951-00890)
Replacer 89
09950-30012
Puller A Set
(09951-03010)
Upper Plate
(09953-03010)
Center Bolt
(09954-03010)
Arm
(09955-03030)
Lower Plate 130
(09956-03020)
Adapter 18
PP–58
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
(09956-03030)
Adaptor 20
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04010)
Hanger 150
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
(09953-04030)
Center Bolt 200
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
(09955-04011)
Claw No.1
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
(09957-04010)
Attachment
(09958-04011)
Holder
PP
PREPARATION – DIFFERENTIAL
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00380)
Replacer 38
PP–59
PP
(09951-00390)
Replacer 39
(09951-00480)
Replacer 48
(09951-00550)
Replacer 55
09950-60020
Replacer Set No.2
(09951-00680)
Replacer 68
(09951-00730)
Replacer 73
(09951-00810)
Replacer 81
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07150)
Handle 150
PP–64
PREPARATION – AXLE
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09905-00012
PP
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
PREPARATION – AXLE
PP–65
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Spring tension gauge
PP
PP–66
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION CONTROL
PREPARATION – AXLE
PP–61
AXLE
PREPARATION
SST
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
09318-12010
Transfer Bearing Adjusting Nut
Wrench
09521-25011
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
09521-25023
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
Attachment
09527-17011
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
09611-12010
Tie Rod End Puller
09628-62011
Boll Joint Puller
09649-17010
Steering Knuckle Tool
09650-17011
Hub Bolt Remover
09710-30021
Suspension Bushing Tool Set
PP
PP–62
PREPARATION – AXLE
(09710-03051)
Bushing Replacer
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
(09957-04010)
Attachment
(09958-04011)
Holder
09950-60020
Replacer Set No.2
PP
(09951-00770)
Replacer 77
PREPARATION – AXLE
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PP–63
PP
(09951-07150)
09951-01000
Handle 150
Replacer 100
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
PP–67
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-20060)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
PP
PP–68
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Tire pressure gauge
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
PP
Angle gauge
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
PP–64
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION CONTROL
SUSPENSION CONTROL
PREPARATION
SST
09730-00010
PP
Tube Remover
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION CONTROL
PP–65
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–72
PREPARATION – BRAKE
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Brake fluid
-
Classification
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
PP–65
SUSPENSION
PREPARATION
SST
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
09223-00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
09612-30012
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
09613-26010
Steering Worm Bearing Cone
Remover
09628-00011
Ball Joint Puller
09628-62011
Boll Joint Puller
09632-36010
Steering Vane Pump Bearing
Replacer
09710-22021
Front Suspension Bushing Tool
Set
(09710-01031)
Upper Arm Bushing Replacer
(09710-01071)
Lower Arm Bushing Remover
(09710-01081)
Lower Arm Bushing Replacer
PP
PP–66
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
09710-26010
Rear Suspension Bushing Tool Set
(09710-05061)
Replacer
(09710-05081)
Rear Base
09727-00060
Arm Set C
09727-30021
Coil Spring Compressor
PP
(09727-00010)
Bolt Set
(09727-00031)
Compressor
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00400)
Replacer 40
09950-60020
(09951-00890)
Replacer Set No.2
Replacer 89
PP–74
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09031-00030
Pin Punch
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
PP
(09043-20060)
09904-00010
(09904-00050)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
Expander Set
No. 4 Claw
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
PP–75
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PP–68
PREPARATION – TIRE AND WHEEL
TIRE AND WHEEL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – TIRE AND WHEEL
PP–69
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Wheel balancer
PP
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
PP–77
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025-00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf-cm)
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
PP
09905-00012
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
PP–78
EQUIPMENT
Caliper gauge
Vernier caliper
Dial indicator
Feeler gauge
Micrometer
PP
Torque wrench
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
PREPARATION – BRAKE CONTROL
PP–69
BRAKE CONTROL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–70
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – BRAKE CONTROL
PP–79
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Power steering fluid (Total)
0.7 liters (0.7 US qts, 0.6 lmp.qts)
Classification
ATF DEXRON II or III
PP
PP–80
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
SSM
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
PP
PP–70
PREPARATION – BRAKE
BRAKE
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
09709-29018
LSPV Gauge Set
PREPARATION – BRAKE
PP–71
EQUIPMENT
Micrometer
Hexagon wrench (5 mm)
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Brake drum gauge
Slide calipers
Torque wrench
PP
PP–80
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040-00011
(09043-30140)
Hexagon Wrench Set
Straight Hexagon Wrench 14
PP
09041-00030
Torx Driver T30
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
09904-00010
Expander Set
(09904-00050)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
No. 4 Claw
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
PP–81
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
Anmeter
Ohmmeter
Vinyl tape
Hexagon wrench 4 mm (0.15 in.)
Hexagon wrench 14 mm (0.55 in.)
Gas leak detector
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Radiator cap tester
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – PARKING BRAKE
PP–71
PARKING BRAKE
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09041-00030
Torx Driver T30
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
PP
PP–72
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Slide calipers
PP
PREPARATION – PARKING BRAKE
PP–82
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Classification
Compressor oil
-
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
PP–72
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
PREPARATION
SST
09316-60011
PP
(09316-00051)
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
Replacer D
09921-00010
Spring Tension Tool
09950-40011
Puller B Set
(09951-04010)
Hanger 150
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
(09958-04011)
Holder
09950-50013
Puller C Set
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
PP–73
PP
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
PP–74
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09023-12701
Union Nut Wrench 17mm
09023-38201
Union Nut Wrench 12mm
09612-00012
Rack & Pinion Steering Rack
Housing Stand
09616-00011
Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Socket
09628-62011
Boll Joint Puller
09631-00350
Steering Rack Cover 35
09631-12071
Steering Rack Oil Seal Test Tool
(09633-00010)
Packing
09631-20060
Bearing Guide Nut Wrench
09631-20081
Seal Ring Tool
09631-20120
Cylinder End Stopper Nut Wrench
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
09640-10010
(09641-01010)
PP–75
Power Steering Pressure Gauge
Set
Gauge Assy
PP
(09641-01030)
Attachment B
(09641-01060)
Attachment E
09922-10010
Variable Open Wrench
09950-60010
Replacer Set
(09951-00180)
Replacer 18
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
(09951-00300)
Replacer 30
(09951-00320)
Replacer 32
(09951-00390)
Replacer 39
(09952-06010)
Adapter
PP–76
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
09950-70010
Handle Set
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
(09951-07150)
Handle 150
(09951-07200)
Handle 200
PP
09960-10010
Variable Pin Wrench Set
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly
(09963-01000)
Pin 10
PP–78
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
PREPARATION
SST
PP
07110-58060
Air Conditioner Service Tool Set
(07117-58060)
Refrigerant Drain Service Valve
(07117-58070)
T-Joint
(07117-58080)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
(07117-58090)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
(07117-78050)
Refrigerant Charging Gauge
(07117-88060)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
(07117-88070)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
(07117-88080)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
09870-00015
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.1
09870-00025
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.2
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
09960-10010
(09962-01000)
PP–79
Variable Pin Wrench Set
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly
PP
(09963-00500)
Pin 5
PREPARATION – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP–83
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Bolt
Length: 35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire with disc wheel
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Plastic bag
Airbag disposal
PP
PREPARATION – SEAT BELT
PP–85
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP–81
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST
09082-00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
09082-00750
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.3
09082-00780
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.6
09082-00802
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-Harness No. 8
(09082-10801)
Wire A
(09082-20801)
Wire B
(09082-30801)
Wire C
09843-18060
SRS Check Wire
PP
PP–82
PREPARATION – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PP
(09083-00150)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Test Lead Set
PP–90
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – WIPER AND WASHER
PREPARATION – WIPER AND WASHER
PP–91
SSM
08850-00065
Butyl Tape Set
PP
PREPARATION – SEAT BELT
PP–83
SEAT BELT
PREPARATION
SST
09082-00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
09082-00770
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.5
PP
PP–84
PREPARATION – SEAT BELT
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PP–84
PREPARATION – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00050
PP
TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
PREPARATION – ENGINE IMMOBILISER
PP–85
ENGINE IMMOBILISER
PREPARATION
SST
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
PP
PP–86
PREPARATION – ENGINE IMMOBILISER
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
PP
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP–86
PREPARATION – CRUISE CONTROL
CRUISE CONTROL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09041-00030
Torx Driver T30
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – CRUISE CONTROL
PP–87
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – LIGHTING
PP–87
LIGHTING
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–88
PREPARATION – WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER
PREPARATION
SST
09843-18040
PP
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
PREPARATION – WIPER AND WASHER
PP–89
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PP
(09083-00150)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – DOOR LOCK
PP–89
DOOR LOCK
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00050
TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
PP
PP–90
PREPARATION – METER
METER
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – METER
PP–91
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Tape
To avoid surface damage
PP
PREPARATION – AUDIO / VISUAL
PP–91
AUDIO / VISUAL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09041-00030
Torx Driver T30
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–92
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – AUDIO / VISUAL
PREPARATION – PARK ASSIST / MONITORING
PP–95
SSM
08850-00065
Butyl Tape Set
PP
PP–98
PREPARATION – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
SSM
Toyota Genuine Windshield Glass Adhesive or Equivalent
PP
PP–92
PREPARATION – NAVIGATION
NAVIGATION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09041-00030
Torx Driver T30
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
HINT:
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – NAVIGATION
PP–93
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
PP–101
EQUIPMENT
Clip remover
Hand riveter
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Torque wrench
PP
PP–102
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
SSM
08850-00065
PP
Butyl Tape Set
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three bond 1324 or Equivalent
PREPARATION – PARK ASSIST / MONITORING
PP–93
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–94
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – PARK ASSIST / MONITORING
PP–102
PREPARATION – EXTERIOR
SSM
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
PP
PP–94
PREPARATION – HORN
HORN
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00050
PP
TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
PREPARATION – OTHER SYSTEM
PP–95
OTHER SYSTEM
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–96
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – OTHER SYSTEM
PP–96
PREPARATION – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PREPARATION – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
PP–97
EQUIPMENT
Adhesive
Knife
Piano wire
Plastic sheet
Sealer gun
Torque wrench
Tape
Wooden block or similar object
PP
PREPARATION – INSTRUMENT PANEL
PP–97
INSTRUMENT PANEL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09041-00030
Torx Driver T30
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
PP
PP–98
PREPARATION – INSTRUMENT PANEL
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Tape
PP
To avoid surface damage
PP–98
PREPARATION – SEAT
SEAT
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
PREPARATION – SEAT
PP–99
EQUIPMENT
Hog ring pliers
Hog ring
Torque wrench
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Scraper
PP
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
PP–99
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
PREPARATION
SST
09812-00010
Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
09812-00020
Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
PP
PP–100
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09041-00020
Torx Driver T25
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09042-00020
Torx Socket T40
09050-00032
Air Drill
09050-20010
Air Riveter
PP
PP–100
PREPARATION – EXTERIOR
EXTERIOR
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09050-00032
Air Drill
09050-02050
Nose Piece No.4
09050-20010
Air Riveter
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
PREPARATION – EXTERIOR
PP–101
EQUIPMENT
Adhesive tape
To avoid surface damage.
Clip remover
Knife
Protective tape
To avoid surface damage.
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – INTERIOR
PP–101
INTERIOR
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
PP
PP–102
PREPARATION – INTERIOR
EQUIPMENT
Adhesive tape
To avoid surface damage.
Clip remover
Protective tape
Torque wrench
PP
To avoid surface damage.
PP–102
PREPARATION – SLIDING ROOF
SLIDING ROOF
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09041-00020
Torx Driver T25
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
PREPARATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
PP–103
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
PP
PP–104
PREPARATION – CAN COMMUNICATION
CAN COMMUNICATION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
Test Lead Set
SS–3
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STANDARD BOLT
HOW TO DETERMINE NUT STRENGTH
Nut Type
Present Standard Hexagon Nut
Old Standard Hexagon Nut
Cold Forging Nut
Class
Cutting Processed Nut
No Mark
No Mark (w/ Washer)
4N
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark
5N (4T)
6N
7N (5T)
8N
No Mark
10N (7T)
11N
12N
HINT:
• *: Nut with 1 or more marks on one side surface of the nut.
• Use a nut with the same nut strength classification number
(or greater) as the bolt strength classification number
when tightening parts with a bolt and nut.
Example:
• Bolt = 4T
• Nut = 4N or more
SS
SS–10
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
Engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1 x Frame assembly
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head subassembly
SS
10 mm (0.39 in.) head
12 mm (0.47 in.) head
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
29
296
21
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
24
245
18
Chain tensioner No. 1 x Cylinder head sub-assembly
10
102
7
Chain tensioner No. 2 x Cylinder head sub-assembly
19
194
14
Chain tensioner No. 3 x Cylinder head sub-assembly
19
194
14
Camshaft timing gear assembly x Camshaft
100
1,020
74
Camshaft timing gear or sprocket x Camshaft
100
1,020
74
Timing chain cover plate x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Ignition coil assembly x Cylinder head cover sub-assembly
10
102
7
V-bank cover sub-assembly x Intake air surge tank
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Engine hanger No. 1 x Cylinder head sub-assembly RH
33
336
24
Engine hanger No. 2 x Cylinder head sub-assembly LH
33
336
24
Spark plug x Cylinder head sub-assembly
20
204
15
Oil filler cap housing x Cylinder head cover sub-assembly LH
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Camshaft timing oil control valve assembly x Cylinder head cover subassembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil filter bracket sub-assembly x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly
19
194
14
Engine mounting bracket front No. 1 RH x Cylinder block sub-assembly
43
435
31
Engine mounting bracket front No. 1 LH x Cylinder block sub-assembly
43
435
31
Engine mounting insulator front No. 1 RH x Frame assembly
38
387
28
Engine mounting insulator front No. 1 LH x Frame assembly
38
387
28
Engine wire No. 2 (ground cable) x Cylinder block sub-assembly
13
133
9
Hood sub-assembly x Hood hinge assembly RH & LH
13
133
10
18
184
13
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Hood support RH & LH x Body
Engine rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
sub-assembly
Nut
Bolt
Knock sensor x Cylinder block sub-assembly
Water outlet pipe No. 1 x Cylinder block sub-assembly
10
102
7
20
204
15
10
102
7
1st
36
367
27
2nd
Turn 180°
Turn 180°
Turn 180°
36
367
27
Turn 180°
Turn 180°
Turn 180°
30
306
22
Chain vibration damper No. 1 x Cylinder block sub-assembly
19
194
14
Idle gear No. 1 x Cylinder block sub-assembly
60
612
44
Cylinder head sub-assembly RH x Cylinder
block sub-assembly
Recessed head 1st
Cylinder head sub-assembly LH x Cylinder
block sub-assembly
2nd
14 mm (0.55 in.) head
Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly x Cylinder head and block
Water pump assembly x Timing chain or belt
cover sub-assembly
10 mm (0.39 in.) head
12 mm (0.47 in.) head
Oil pan drain plug x Oil pan sub-assembly No. 2
17
92
80 in.*lbf
23
235
17
41
35 in.*lbf
Bolt A
21
214
15
Bolt B
21
214
15
Bolt C
10
102
7
Nut
21
214
15
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil strainer sub-assembly x Oil pan sub-assembly
Oil pan sub-assembly No. 2 x Oil pan subassembly
235
4.0
Oil pan stud bolt x Oil pan sub-assembly
Oil pan sub-assembly x Cylinder block and
timing chain or belt cover
23
9.0
Bolt
Nut
10
102
7
40
408
30
SS–11
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
250
2,549
184
Bolt A
10
102
7
Bolt B
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Nut
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Bolt A
10
102
7
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
Cylinder head cover sub-assembly x Cylinder
head sub-assembly RH
Cylinder head cover sub-assembly LH x
Cylinder head sub-assembly LH
Bolt B
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Nut
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Ventilation valve x Cylinder head cover sub-assembly LH
27
275
20
Oil control valve filter plug x Cylinder head sub-assembly
62
632
46
Crankshaft position sensor x Cylinder block sub-assembly
10
102
7
VVT sensor x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Cylinder block water drain cock sub-assembly x Cylinder block subassembly
25
255
18
Oil level gauge guide x Cylinder head sub-assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil pan sub-assembly x Transmission
37
377
27
Idler pulley sub-assembly No. 1 x Timing chain or belt cover subassembly
54
551
40
Idler pulley sub-assembly No. 2 x Timing chain or belt cover subassembly
39
398
29
V-ribbed belt tensioner assembly x Cylinder block sub-assembly
36
367
27
Vane pump assembly x Cylinder block sub-assembly
43
438
32
Intake air surge tank x Intake manifold
26
265
19
Surge tank stay x Intake air surge tank and cylinder head
21
214
15
Throttle body bracket x Throttle body with motor and cylinder head
21
214
15
Oil baffle plate x Surge tank stay No. 1
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Ground cable x Cylinder head sub-assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Water by-pass joint RR x Cylinder head sub-assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Intake manifold x Cylinder head sub-assembly
26
265
19
Exhaust manifold sub-assembly RH x Cylinder head sub-assembly RH
30
306
22
Exhaust manifold sub-assembly LH x Cylinder head sub-assembly LH
30
306
22
Manifold stay x Exhaust manifold sub-assembly RH and transmission
40
408
30
Manifold stay No. 2 x Exhaust manifold sub-assembly LH and
transmission
40
408
30
Transmission oil filler tube sub-assembly x Cylinder head sub-assembly
12
122
9
Cool air inlet No. 1 x Body
12
122
9
Drive plate & ring gear sub-assembly x Crankshaft
83
846
61
A
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
B
Stud bolt x Cylinder head sub-assembly and
cylinder head LH
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Union x Cylinder head sub-assembly and cylinder head LH
15
150
11
With Head taper screw plug x Cylinder head sub-assembly and cylinder
head LH
80
816
59
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
1st
25
250
18
2nd
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
12 pointed head 1st
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block subassembly
Stud bolt x Cylinder block sub-assembly
61
622
45
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
12 mm head
26
262
19
A
11
112
8.1
2nd
B
4.5
46
40 in.*lbf
C
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Sub-assembly oil nozzle No. 1 x Cylinder block sub-assembly
SS
SS–15
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Oil pan sub-assembly No. 2 x Drain plug
39
398
29
Cylinder head cover sub-assembly LH x Ventilation valve sub-assembly
27
275
20
Bolt
18
183
13
Nut
18
183
13
Oil pump assembly x Oil cooler assembly
Water by-pass joint FR x Cylinder head
18
185
13
Water by-pass pipe x Cylinder block
18
185
13
Starter assembly x Cylinder block
39
400
29
Starter assembly x Engine wire No. 2
9.8
100
7.2
Water by-pass joint RR x Cylinder head
18
185
13
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
45
450
33
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump assembly
6.5
65
58 in.*lbf
Camshaft position sensor x Cylinder head
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Ignition coil assembly x Cylinder head cover
Fan bracket sub-assembly x Cylinder block
V-ribbed belt tensioner assembly x Cylinder
block
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
12 mm head
16
160
12
14 mm head
32
326
24
Bolt
16
160
12
Nut
Timing belt cover sub-assembly No. 2 x Cylinder block
Timing chain or belt cover No. 2 x Cylinder
block
16
160
12
16
160
12
Bolt
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Nut
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Timing belt cover sub-assembly No. 3 LH x Cylinder block
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Pump bracket x Cylinder block
43
438
32
Oil cooler pipe x Cylinder block
Bolt
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Nut
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Harness bracket x Cylinder block
8.0
80
71 in.*lbf
Engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
36
367
27
Wire harness heat insulator No. 2 x Cylinder block
17
175
13
Intake manifold assembly x Cylinder head
18
185
13
Engine mounting bracket x Frame brackets
38
387
28
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
44
450
33
Exhaust manifold heat insulator x Exhaust manifold
7.5
80
69 in.*lbf
Oil level gauge guide x Cylinder head
15
155
11
Transmission oil filler tube x Cylinder head
12
122
9
Fan with fluid coupling x Fan bracket sub-assembly
29
296
21
Bolt
47
475
34
Nut
25
255
18
Bolt
43
438
32
Nut
43
438
32
Compressor x Cylinder block
Vane pump assembly x Cylinder block
Fan shroud x Radiator assembly
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Air cleaner assembly x Body
12
122
9
Throttle body cover x Intake manifold assembly
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Hood x Body
13
133
10
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
16
158
11
31
311
23
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Engine rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
Oil pump assembly x Cylinder block
Bolt A, B, C and E
Bolt D
Oil strainer sub-assembly x Cylinder block
Oil pan sub-assembly x Cylinder block
Bolt A and D
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Bolt B, C and nut
28
286
21
SS
SS–16
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Part Tightened
Oil pan baffle plate x Oil pan sub-assembly
Oil pan sub-assembly No. 2 x Oil pan sub-assembly
Water pump assembly x Cylinder block
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
SS
Bearing cap x Cylinder head
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Bolt
21
214
15
Stud bolt and nut
18
184
13
1st
40
408
30
2nd
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
3rd
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Bolt C
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Other
16
163
12
Timing belt plate RR x Cylinder head
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Timing belt idler sub-assembly No. 2 x Cylinder block
35
352
25
Timing belt idler sub-assembly No. 1 x Cylinder block
35
352
25
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
108
1,101
80
Chain tensioner assembly x Oil pump assembly
26
270
19
Timing belt No. 1 over x Cylinder block
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Crankshaft damper x Crankshaft
245
2,498
181
Idler pulley sub-assembly No. 2
39
398
29
Oil filler cap housing x Cylinder head cover
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head
17.5
178
13
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block
1st
25
250
18
2nd
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
1st
27
275
20
2nd
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
Drive plate & ring gear x Crankshaft
6.0
60
53 in.*lbf
1st
49
500
36
2nd
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
Turn 90°
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Camshaft drive gear x Camshaft timing tube assembly
Camshaft timing tube assembly x Camshaft
78
795
58
Screw plug x Camshaft timing tube assembly
15
152
11
Timing belt plate RR x Cylinder head
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
SS–1
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STANDARD BOLT
STANDARD BOLT
HOW TO DETERMINE BOLT
STRENGTH
Bolt Type
Hexagon Head Bolt
Stud Bolt
Normal Recess Bolt
Weld Bolt
Class
Deep Recess Bolt
No Mark
No Mark
No Mark
4T
5T
w/ Washer
w/ Washer
6T
7T
8T
9T
10T
11T
SS
SS–2
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STANDARD BOLT
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD
BOLTS
Class
4T
SS
5T
6T
7T
8T
9T
10T
11T
Diameter
(mm)
Pitch
(mm)
Specified torque
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
6
1
5
55
48 in.*lbf
6
60
52 in.*lbf
8
1.25
12.5
130
9
14
145
10
10
1.25
26
260
19
29
290
21
12
1.25
47
480
35
53
540
39
14
1.5
74
760
55
84
850
61
Hexagon head bolt
Hexagon flange bolt
16
1.5
115
1,150
83
-
-
-
6
1
6.5
65
56 in.*lbf
7.5
75
65 in.*lbf
8
1.25
15.5
160
12
17.5
175
13
10
1.25
32
330
24
36
360
26
12
1.25
59
600
43
65
670
48
14
1.5
91
930
67
100
1,050
76
16
1.5
140
1,400
101
-
-
-
6
1
8
80
69 in.*lbf
9
90
78 in.*lbf
8
1.25
19
195
14
21
210
15
10
1.25
39
400
29
44
440
32
12
1.25
71
730
53
80
810
59
14
1.5
110
1,100
80
125
1,250
90
16
1.5
170
1,750
127
-
-
-
6
1
10.5
110
8
12
120
9
8
1.25
25
260
19
28
290
21
10
1.25
52
530
38
58
590
43
12
1.25
95
970
70
105
1,050
76
14
1.5
145
1,500
108
165
1,700
123
16
1.5
230
2,300
166
-
-
-
8
1.25
29
300
22
33
330
24
10
1.25
61
620
45
68
690
50
12
1.25
110
1,100
80
120
1,250
90
8
1.25
34
340
25
37
380
27
10
1.25
70
710
51
78
790
57
12
1.25
125
1,300
94
140
1,450
105
8
1.25
38
390
28
42
430
31
10
1.25
78
800
58
88
890
64
12
1.25
140
1,450
105
155
1,600
116
8
1.25
42
430
31
47
480
35
10
1.25
87
890
64
97
990
72
12
1.25
155
1,600
116
175
1,800
130
SS–4
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL
SYSTEM
SERVICE DATA
Throttle body
Standard throttle valve opening angle
60% or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
SS
Voltage (ACCEL POS)
Voltage (ACCEL POS#2)
Camshaft timing oil control valve
assembly
Accelerator pedal released
0.5 to 1.1 V
Accelerator pedal depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
Accelerator pedal released
1.2 to 2.0 V
Accelerator pedal depressed
3.4 to 5.3 V
VVT system is OFF (OCV is OFF)
Normal engine speed
VVT system is ON (OCV is ON)
Rough idle or engine stalled
at 20°C (68°F)
6.9 to 7.9 Ω
at 20°C (68°F)
0.3 to 100 Ω
at 20°C (68°F)
120 to 280 kΩ
at 20°C (68°F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
at 80°C (176°F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
3-5
Continuity (Apply battery voltage terminal 1 and 2)
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
3-5
Continuity (Apply battery voltage terminal 1 and 2)
Camshaft timing oil control valve assembly
Resistance
Throttle with Motor body assembly
Resistance
Knock sensor
Resistance
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Resistance
Circuit opening relay
Specified condition
EFI relay
Specified condition
SS–5
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Throttle with motor body assembly x Intake air surge tank
11
112
9
Air cleaner assembly x Cylinder head cover sub-assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Air cleaner assembly x Intake air surge tank
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
V-bank cover x Air cleaner assembly
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
V-bank cover x Intake air surge tank
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Knock sensor x Cylinder block sub-assembly
20
204
15
Water outlet pipe No. 1 x Cylinder block sub-assembly
10
102
7
ECM x Body
13
133
10
Accelerator pedal rod assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SS–5
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL
SYSTEM
SERVICE DATA
Throttle body
Standard throttle valve opening
percentage
60% or more
Accelerator pedal released
0.5 to 1.1 V
Accelerator pedal depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
Accelerator pedal released
1.2 to 2.0 V
Accelerator pedal depressed
3.4 to 5.3 V
at -20°C (-4°F)
12.5 to 16.9 kΩ
at 20°C (68°F)
2.19 to 2.67 kΩ
at 60°C (140°F)
0.50 to 0.68 kΩ
at 20°C (68°F)
6.9 to 7.9 Ω
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Voltage (ACCEL POS)
Voltage (ACCEL POS#2)
Mass air flow meter
Resistance
Camshaft timing oil control valve assembly
Resistance
Throttle with motor body
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
0.3 to 100 Ω
Knock control sensor
at 20°C (68°F)
120 to 280 kΩ
Approx. 20°C (68°F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
Approx. 80°C (176°F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Resistance
Circuit opening relay
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω (Apply battery voltage to terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω (Apply battery voltage to terminals 1 and 2)
EFI relay
Specified condition
SS
SS–6
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Throttle body assembly x Intake manifold
14
143
10
V-bank cover x Intake manifold
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Knock sensor x Cylinder block assembly
20
204
15
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
18
185
13
V-bank cover bracket x Intake manifold
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Wire bracket x Intake manifold
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
ECM x Body
13
133
10
Accelerator pedal rod assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
SS–6
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SERVICE DATA
Ignition timing
Terminals TC and CG of DLC3
connected
10 +- 2° BTDC idle (Transmission in neutral)
Terminals TC and CG of DLC3
disconnected
7 to 24° BTDC idle (Transmission in neutral)
Idle speed
SS
Compression
700 +- 50 rpm (Transmission in neutral)
Compression pressure
1.3 MPa (13.3 kgf/cm2, 189 psi) or more
Minimum pressure
1.0 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder
0.1 MPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi) or less
Valve clearance
Intake
(cold)
Exhaust
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
0.29 to 0.39 mm (0.011 to 0.015 in.)
Intake manifold
Intake air surge tank side warpage
Maximum
Cylinder head side warpage
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
Exhaust manifold
Warpage
Maximum
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Camshaft timing gear assembly
Diameter (with chain)
Large gear
115.5 mm (4.547 in.)
Small gear
73.1 mm (2.878 in.)
Camshaft timing gear or sprocket
Diameter (with chain)
73.1 mm (2.878 in.)
Crankshaft timing gear or sprocket
Diameter (with chain)
61.0 mm (2.402 in.)
Idle gear No. 1
Diameter (with chain)
61.0 mm (2.402 in.)
Cylinder head set bolt
Outside diameter
Standard
10.85 to 11.00 mm (0.4272 to 0.4331 in.)
Minimum
10.7 mm (0.421 in.)
Maximum
146.8 mm (5.780 in.)
Maximum
146.8 mm (5.780 in.)
Chain
Elongation
No. 2 chain
Elongation
Idle gear shaft
Idle gear shaft diameter
22.987 to 23.000 mm (0.9050 to 0.9055 in.)
Idle gear inside diameter
23.02 to 23.03 mm (0.9063 to 0.9067 in.)
Oil clearance
Standard
0.020 to 0.043 mm (0.0008 to 0.0017 in.)
Maximum
0.093 mm (0.0037 in.)
Maximum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Maximum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Maximum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Maximum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Maximum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Chain tensioner assembly No. 2
Worn depth
Chain tensioner assembly No. 3
Worn depth
Chain tensioner slipper
Worn depth
Chain vibration damper No. 1
Worn depth
Chain vibration damper No. 2
Worn depth
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SS–7
Cylinder head sub-assembly
Warpage
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Intake valve
Valve stem diameter
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
Valve face angle
Margin thickness
Overall length
44.5°
Standard
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Standard
106.95 mm (4.2106 in.)
Minimum
106.40 mm (4.1890 in.)
Exhaust valve
Valve stem diameter
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2158 in.)
Valve face angle
44.5°
Margin thickness
Overall length
Standard
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Standard
105.80 mm (4.1653 in.)
Minimum
105.30 mm (4.1457 in.)
Maximum
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
at 33.3 mm (1.311 in.)
186.2 to 205.8 N (19.0 to 21.0 kgf, 41.9 to 46.3 lbf)
Inner compression spring
Deviation
Free length
Tension
47.80 mm (1.8819 in.)
Intake valve guide bush
Inside diameter
Oil clearance
5.51 to 5.53 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
Standard
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Bush bore diameter
10.295 to 10.315 mm (0.4053 to 0.4061 in.)
Protrusion height
9.3 to 9.7 mm (0.366 to 0.382 in.)
Exhaust valve guide bush
Inside diameter
Oil clearance
5.51 to 5.53 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
Standard
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Bush bore diameter
10.295 to 10.315 mm (0.4053 to 0.4061 in.)
Protrusion height
9.3 to 9.7 mm (0.366 to 0.382 in.)
Valve lifter
Diameter
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
Lifter bore diameter
Oil clearance
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
Standard
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
No. 1 journal
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Other journals
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
No. 1 camshaft
Journal diameter
Circuit runout
Cam lobe height
Oil clearance
Thrust clearance
No. 2 camshaft
Maximum
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Standard
44.168 to 44.268 mm (1.7389 to 1.7428 in.)
Minimum
44.018 mm (1.7330 in.)
Standard No. 1 journal
0.008 to 0.038 mm (0.0003 to 0.0015 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum No. 1 journal
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Other journals
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Standard
0.04 to 0.09 mm (0.0016 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
SS
SS–8
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Journal diameter
Circuit runout
Cam lobe height
Oil clearance
SS
Thrust clearance
No. 1 journal
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Other journals
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
Maximum
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Standard
44.580 to 44.680 mm (1.7551 to 1.7591 in.)
Minimum
44.430 mm (1.7492 in.)
Standard No. 1 journal
0.040 to 0.079 mm (0.0016 to 0.0031 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Standard
0.04 to 0.09 mm (0.0016 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
No. 1 journal
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Other journals
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
Maximum
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
No. 3 camshaft sub-assembly
Journal diameter
Circuit runout
Cam lobe height
Oil clearance
Thrust clearance
Standard
44.168 to 44.268 mm (1.7389 to 1.7428 in.)
Minimum
44.018 mm (1.7330 in.)
Standard No. 1 journal
0.040 to 0.079 mm (0.0016 to 0.0031 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Standard
0.04 to 0.09 mm (0.0016 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
No. 4 camshaft sub-assembly
Journal diameter
Circuit runout
Cam lobe height
Oil clearance
Thrust clearance
No. 1 journal
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Other journals
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
Maximum
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Standard
44.580 to 44.680 mm (1.7551 to 1.7591 in.)
Minimum
44.430 mm (1.7492 in.)
Standard No. 1 journal
0.040 to 0.079 mm (0.0016 to 0.0031 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Standard
0.04 to 0.09 mm (0.0016 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
Ring pin for cylinder head sub-assembly and cylinder head LH
Protrusion height
2.7 to 3.3 mm (0.106 to 0.130 in.)
Straight pin for cylinder head sub-assembly and cylinder head LH
A
Protrusion height
17.5 to 19.5 mm (0.689 to 0.768 in.)
B
7.5 to 8.5 mm (0.295 to 0.335 in.)
C
7.0 to 9.0 mm (0.276 to 0.354 in.)
Tight plug for cylinder head sub-assembly and cylinder head LH
Depth
Connecting rod thrust clearance
Connecting rod oil clearance
Crankshaft thrust clearance
Cylinder block warpage
Cylinder bore diameter
Piston diameter
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
Standard
0.15 to 0.30 mm (0.0059 to 0.0118 in.)
Maximum
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Standard
0.026 to 0.046 mm (0.0010 to 0.0018 in.)
Maximum
0.066 mm (0.0025 in.)
Standard
0.04 to 0.24 mm (0.0016 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Standard
94.000 to 94.012 mm (3.7008 to 3.7013 in.)
Maximum
94.132 mm (3.7060 in.)
93.910 to 93.920 mm (3.6972 to 3.6976 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Standard
0.080 to 0.102 mm (0.0031 to 0.0040 in.)
Maximum
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
Connecting rod out-of-alignment
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Connecting rod twist
Maximum
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Oil clearance
Connecting rod bushing inside diameter
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
Piston pin diameter
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
Oil clearance
Piston ring groove clearance
Piston ring end gap
Connecting rod bolt diameter
Standard
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
Maximum
0.050 mm (0.0020 in.)
No. 1
0.02 to 0.07 mm (0.0008 to 0.0028 in.)
No. 2
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
Oil
0.07 to 0.15 mm (0.0028 to 0.0060 in.)
Standard No. 1
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.0118 to 0.0157 in.)
No. 2
0.40 to 0.50 mm (0.0157 to 0.0197 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.10 to 0.40 mm (0.0039 to 0.0157 in.)
Maximum No. 1
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
No. 2
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Standard
7.2 to 7.3 mm (0.283 to 0.287 in.)
Minimum
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
Crankshaft bearing cap set bolt diameter
Standard
10.0 to 10.2 mm (0.393 to 0.402 in.)
Crankshaft circle runout
Maximum
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Main journal diameter
Main journal taper and out-of-round
71.988 to 72.000 mm (2.8342 to 2.8346 in.)
Maximum
Crank pin diameter
Crank pin taper and out-of-round
Crankshaft oil clearance
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
55.992 to 56.000 mm (2.2044 to 2.2047 in.)
Maximum
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Standard
0.018 to 0.030 mm (0.0007 to 0.0012 in.)
Maximum
0.046 mm (0.0018 in.)
SS–9
SS
SS–12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SERVICE DATA
Ignition timing
Terminals TC and CG of DLC3
connected
Idle speed
SS
Compression
5 to 15° BTDC at idle (Transmission in neutral)
650 to 750 r/min
Compression pressure
1,373 kPa (14.0 kgf/cm2, 199 psi) or more
Minimum pressure
1,030 kPa (10.5 kgf/cm2, 149 psi)
Difference between each cylinder
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
Valve clearance
Intake
(cold)
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
(cold)
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.039 in.)
Cylinder head
Warpage
Valve seat
Refacing angle
30°, 45°, 60°
Contacting angle
45°
Contacting width
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
Valve guide bushing bore diameter
Cylinder head seat bolt thread inside
diameter
Protrusion height
STD
10.285 to 10.306 mm (0.4049 to 0.4057 in.)
O/S 0.05
10.335 to 10.356 mm (0.4069 to 0.4077 in.)
STD
9.810 to 9.960 mm (0.3862 to 0.3921 in.)
Minimum
9.70 mm (0.3819 in.)
Intake
9.2 to 9.8 mm (0.362 to 0.386 in.)
Exhaust
8.2 to 8.8 mm (0.323 to 0.346 in.)
Valve guide bushing
Inside diameter
Outside diameter (for repair part)
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
STD
10.285 to 10.306 mm (0.4049 to 0.4057 in.)
O/S 0.05
10.335 to 10.356 mm (0.4069 to 0.4077 in.)
STD Intake
95.05 mm (3.7421 in.)
Valve
Valve overall length
Exhaust
95.10 mm (3.7441 in.)
Minimum Intake
94.55 mm (3.7224 in.)
Exhaust
94.60 mm (3.7244 in.)
Valve face angle
Stem diameter
Stem oil clearance
Margin thickness
44.5°
Intake
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
Exhaust
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2157 in.)
STD Intake
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Maximum Intake
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
STD IN
1.25 mm (0.049 in.)
EX
1.4 mm (0.055 in.)
Minimum
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Maximum
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
Valve spring
Deviation
Free length
54.1 mm (2.130 in.)
Installed tension at 35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
210 to 226 N (21.4 to 23.0 kgf*cm, 47.2 to 50.7 lbf)
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
30.968 to 30.976 mm (1.2192 to 1.2195 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Lifter bore diameter
Oil clearance
SS–13
31.000 to 31.016 mm (1.2205 to 1.2211 in.)
STD
0.024 to 0.050 mm (0.0009 to 0.0020 in.)
Maximum
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
STD Intake
0 to 0.040 mm (0 to 0.0016 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 to 0.070 mm (0.0012 to 0.0028 in.)
Minimum Intake
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Camshaft
Thrust clearance
Journal oil diameter
STD
0.030 to 0.071 mm (0.012 to 0.0028 in.)
Maximum
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Maximum
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
STD Intake
41.94 to 42.04 mm (1.6512 to 1.6551 in.)
Exhaust
41.96 to 42.06 mm (1.6520 to 1.6559 in.)
Minimum Intake
41.79 mm (1.6453 in.)
Exhaust
41.81 mm (1.6461 in.)
Journal diameter
Circuit runout
Cam lobe height
Camshaft gear backlash
26.954 to 26.970 mm (1.0612 to 1.0618 in.)
STD
0.020 to 0.200 mm (0.0008 to 0.0079 in.)
Maximum
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Camshaft gear bolt washer end free distance
18.2 to 18.8 mm (0.717 to 0.740 in.)
Cylinder block
Cylinder head surface warpage
Cylinder bore diameter
Main bearing cap bolt tension portion
diameter
Maximum
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
STD Mark 1
94.002 to 94.010 mm (3.7009 to 3.7012 in.)
Mark 2
94.010 to 94.023 mm (3.7012 to 3.7017 in.)
Mark 3
94.023 to 94.031 mm (3.7017 to 3.7020 in.)
Maximum STD
94.231 mm (3.7099 in.)
O/S 0.5
94.731 mm (3.7296 in.)
STD
10.760 to 10.970 mm (0.4236 to 0.4319 in.)
Minimum
10.40 mm (0.4094 in.)
STD Mark 1
93.902 to 93.912 mm (3.6969 to 3.6973 in.)
Mark 2
93.912 to 93.920 mm (3.6973 to 3.6976 in.)
Mark 3
93.920 to 93.930 mm (3.6976 to 3.6980 in.)
Piston and piston ring
Piston diameter
Piston oil clearance
Piston ring groove clearance
Piston ring end gap
O/S 0.5
94.402 to 94.430 mm (3.7168 to 3.7177 in.)
STD
0.090 to 0.111 mm (0.0035 to 0.0044 in.)
Maximum
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
No. 1
0.030 to 0.080 mm (0.0012 to 0.0032 in.)
No. 2
0.020 to 0.060 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
No. 1
0.300 to 0.400 mm (0.0118 to 0.0158 in.)
No. 2
0.400 to 0.550 mm (0.0158 to 0.0217 in.)
Oil
0.130 to 0.380 mm (0.0051 to 0.0150 in.)
Maximum No. 1
1.10 mm (0.0433 in.)
No. 2
1.30 mm (0.0512 in.)
Oil
0.90 mm (0.0354 in.)
Camshaft timing tube assembly
Journal oil diameter
STD
0.036 to 0.057 mm (0.0014 to 0.0022 in.)
Maximum
0.075 mm (0.0030 in.)
STD
0.160 to 0.290 mm (0.0063 to 0.0114 in.)
Maximum
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Connecting rod
Thrust clearance
Connecting rod thickness
22.880 to 22.920 mm (0.9008 to 0.9024 in.)
SS
SS–14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Connecting rod oil clearance
Connecting rod bearing center wall
thickness
SS
STD
0.021 to 0.047 mm (0.0008 to 0.0019 in.)
Maximum
0.065 mm (0.0026 in.)
Mark 2
1.487 to 1.490 mm (0.0585 to 0.0587 in.)
Mark 3
1.490 to 1.493 mm (0.0587 to 0.0588 in.)
Mark 4
1.493 to 1.496 mm (0.0588 to 0.0589 in.)
Mark 5
1.496 to 1.499 mm (0.0589 to 0.0590 in.)
Mark 6
1.499 to 1.502 mm (0.0590 to 0.0591 in.)
Mark 7
1.502 to 1.505 mm (0.0591 to 0.0593 in.)
Rod bend
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rod twist
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Bushing inside diameter
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
Piston pin diameter
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
Bushing oil clearance
Connecting rod bolt tension portion
diameter
STD
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
STD
7.200 to 7.300 mm (0.2835 to 0.2874 in.)
Maximum
7.00 mm (0.2756 in.)
STD
0.020 to 0.220 mm (0.0008 to 0.0087 in.)
Maximum
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
STD
2.440 to 2.490 mm (0.0961 to 0.0980 in.)
Crankshaft
Thrust clearance
Thrust washer thickness
U/S 0.125
Main journal bore diameter on cylinder block
Main journal oil clearance
No. 1 and No. 5 STD
0.028 to 0.046 mm (0.0011 to 0.0018 in.)
Others STD
0.040 to 0.058 mm (0.0016 to 0.0023 in.)
No. 1 and No. 5 Maximum
0.065 mm (0.0026 in.)
Others Maximum
0.065 mm (0.0026 in.)
Main journal diameter
Main bearing center wall thickness
2.503 to 2.553 mm (0.0985 to 0.1005 in.)
72.000 to 72.016 mm (2.8347 to 2.8353 in.)
66.988 to 67.000 mm (2.6373 to 2.6378 in.)
No. 1 and No. 5 Mark 3
2.487 to 2.490 mm (0.0979 to 0.0980 in.)
Mark 4
2.490 to 2.493 mm (0.0980 to 0.0982 in.)
Mark 5
2.493 to 2.496 mm (0.0982 to 0.0983 in.)
Mark 6
2.496 to 2.499 mm (0.0983 to 0.0984 in.)
Mark 7
2.499 to 2.502 mm (0.0984 to 0.0985 in.)
Other Mark 1
2.481 to 2.484 mm (0.0977 to 0.0978 in.)
Mark 2
2.484 to 2.487 mm (0.0978 to 0.0979 in.)
Mark 3
2.487 to 2.490 mm (0.0979 to 0.0980 in.)
Mark 4
2.490 to 2.493 mm (0.0980 to 0.0982 in.)
Mark 5
Crank pin diameter
2.493 to 2.496 mm (0.0981 to 0.0983 in.)
51.982 to 52.000 mm (2.0465 to 2.0472 in.)
Circle runout
Maximum
0.04 mm (0.0016 in.)
Main journal taper and out-of-round
Maximum
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Crank pin taper and out-of-round
Maximum
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE FUEL
SS–17
1GR-FE FUEL
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
281 to 287 kPa (2.87 to 2.93 kgf/cm2, 40.8 to 41.7 psi)
Fuel pressure
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
Fuel injector
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
11.6 to 12.4 Ω
Injection volume
76 to 91 cm2 (4.6 to 5.5 cu in.) per 15 seconds
Difference between each cylinder
15 cm3 (0.9 cu in.) or less
Fuel leakage
1 drop or less per 12 minutes
Fuel pump resister
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
0.70 to 0.76 Ω
at 20°C (68°F)
0.2 to 3.0 Ω
1-2
Continuity
3-4
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
Fuel Pump
Resistance
Fuel pump relay assembly
Specified condition
SS
SS–18
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE FUEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Fuel delivery pipe sub-assembly x Intake manifold
15
153
11
Intake air surge tank x Intake manifold
28
286
21
Intake air surge tank x Throttle body bracket
21
214
16
Intake air surge tank x Surge tank stay No. 1
21
214
16
Intake air surge tank x Surge tank stay No. 2
21
214
16
Fuel pressure regulator assembly x Fuel delivery pipe sub-assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Fuel tank x Body
40
408
30
Fuel tank protector sub-assembly No. 1 x Body
20
204
15
SS–18
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE FUEL
2UZ-FE FUEL
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
265 to 304 kPa (2.7 to 3.1 kgf/cm2, 38 to 44 psi)
Fuel pressure
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
Fuel injector
Resistance
SS
at 20°C (68°F)
13.4 to 14.2 Ω
Injection volume
56 to 69 cm2 (3.4 to 4.2 cu in.) per 15 seconds
Difference between each cylinder
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
Fuel leakage
1 drop or less per 12 minutes
Fuel pump resister
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
0.70 to 0.76 Ω
Fuel suction with pump & gage tube assembly
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
0.2 to 3.0 Ω
1-2
Continuity
3-4
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
Fuel pump relay assembly
Specified condition
SS–19
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE FUEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Delivery pipe x Intake manifold
21
214
16
Delivery pipe No. 2 x Intake manifold
21
214
16
Fuel hose x Delivery pipe
39
400
29
Vacuum switching valve assembly No. 1 x Intake manifold
18
185
13
Fuel pipe sub-assembly No. 3 x Intake manifold
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Fuel pipe sub-assembly No. 1 x Delivery pipe
39
400
29
Throttle body cover sub-assembly x Intake manifold
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Fuel tank x Body
40
408
30
Fuel tank protector sub-assembly No. 1 x Body
20
204
15
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL
SS–19
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
VSV for charcoal canister
at 20°C (68°F)
25 to 30 Ω
at 100°C (212°F)
32 to 42 Ω
at 20°C (68°F)
26 to 30 Ω
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
No continuity
Resistance
Vacuum switching valve assembly No. 1
Resistance
Air fuel ratio sensor (Bank 1, Bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor No. 2 (Bank 1, Bank 2)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 4 (E1)
No continuity
Power source voltage
VC - E2
4.5 to 5.5 V
Power output voltage
PTNK - E2
3.0 to 3.6 V
Vapor pressure sensor
SS
SS–20
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Charcoal canister x Body
20
204
15
Charcoal canister filter No. 2 x Body
20
204
15
SS–20
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
VSV for charcoal canister
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
25 to 30 Ω
at 100°C (212°F)
32 to 42 Ω
at 20°C (68°F)
26 to 30 Ω
VSV for EVAP
SS
Resistance
Heated oxygen sensor
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 4 (E1)
No continuity
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 4 (E1)
No continuity
Heated oxygen sensor No. 2 (Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor No. 2 (Bank 2)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Resistance
1 (HT) - 4 (E1)
No continuity
AIP-E2
1.0 to 2.2 V
1-2
33 to 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Pressure sensor
Voltage
Vacuum switching valve assembly
Resistance
1-Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
2-Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
SS–21
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Charcoal canister x Body
20
204
15
Charcoal canister filter No. 2 x Body
20
204
15
Air pump assembly x Air pump bracket
10
102
7
Air pump assembly with bracket x Cylinder block assembly
16
163
12
Air switching valve assembly x Air pump bracket
16
163
12
Pressure sensor x Air pump bracket
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Air switching valve assembly No. 2 x water by-pass joint rear
10
102
7
Air tube No. 3 x Air switching valve assembly No. 2
10
102
7
Air tube No. 3 x Exhaust manifold
10
102
7
Air tube No. 2 x Air switching valve assembly No. 2
10
102
7
Air tube No. 2 x Exhaust manifold
10
102
7
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE INTAKE
SS–21
1GR-FE INTAKE
SERVICE DATA
VSV for ACIS
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 to 39 Ω
SS
SS–22
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE INTAKE
2UZ-FE INTAKE
SERVICE DATA
Vacuum switching valve assembly for IAC valve
Resistance
SS
Between each terminal
33 to 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Between each terminal-Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
SS–23
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE EXHAUST
1GR-FE EXHAUST
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Exhaust pipe assembly front x Exhaust manifold
Part Tightened
62
630
46
Exhaust front pipe assembly No. 2 x Exhaust pipe assembly center
(Bolt)
48
490
35
Exhaust front pipe assembly No. 2 x Exhaust pipe assembly center
(Nut)
62
630
46
Exhaust pipe assembly center x Tail pipe
48
490
35
Heated oxygen sensor x Exhaust pipe assembly front
44
450
33
Heated oxygen sensor x Exhaust front pipe assembly No. 2
44
450
33
SS
SS–24
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE EXHAUST
2UZ-FE EXHAUST
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
62
633
46
Bolt
48
489
35
Nut
62
633
46
Center exhaust pipe x Tail pipe
48
489
35
Heated oxygen sensor x Front exhaust pipe
44
450
30
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE COOLING
SS–25
1GR-FE COOLING
SERVICE DATA
Water inlet with thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
at 95°C (203°F)
8 mm (0.31 in.) or more
Radiator cap
Relief valve opening pressure
Standard
93 to 123 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/cm2, 13.5 to 17.8 psi)
Minimum
78 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
SS
SS–26
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE COOLING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Cylinder block water drain cock plug x Cylinder block water drain cock
13
130
9
Water pump assembly x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly (10
mm (0.39 in.) head)
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Water pump assembly x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly (12
mm (0.47 in.) head)
23
235
17
Idler pulley sub-assembly No. 2 x Timing chain or belt cover subassembly
39
398
29
Water inlet x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Fan shroud x Radiator
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Fan with fluid coupling x Water pump
21
214
15
V-bank cover x Intake air surge tank
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1 x Frame assembly
29
296
21
Water inlet with thermostat x Water inlet
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Radiator x Radiator support
18
184
13
SS–26
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE COOLING
2UZ-FE COOLING
SERVICE DATA
Thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
at 95°C (203°F)
10 mm (0.39 in.) or more
Radiator cap
SS
Relief valve opening pressure
Standard
93 to 123 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/cm2, 13.5 to 17.8 psi)
Minimum
78 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
SS–27
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE COOLING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
Drain plug x Union on cylinder block
13
130
9
Fan x Fluid coupling
5.5
55
47 in.*lbf
Water pump x Cylinder block
ft.*lbf
Bolt
21
215
16
Stud bolt and nut
18
185
13
Water inlet housing x Water pump
18
185
13
Water inlet x Water inlet housing
19
195
14
Radiator x Radiator support
18
184
13
Fan shroud x Radiator
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Radiator reserve tank x Fan shroud
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
SS–27
1GR-FE LUBRICATION
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
at idle speed
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.2 psi) or more
at 3,000 rpm
294 to 588 kPa (3.0 to 6.0 kgf/cm2, 43 to 85 psi)
Oil pump
Tip clearance
Standard
Maximum
Side clearance
Standard
Maximum
Body clearance
Standard
Maximum
0.06 to 0.16 mm (0.0024 to 0.0063 in.)
0.16 mm (0.0063 in.)
0.03 to 0.09 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
0.325 mm (0.0128 in.)
SS
SS–28
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE LUBRICATION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Oil pressure switch x Oil filter bracket sub-assembly
15
152
11
Oil pan drain plug x Oil pan sub-assembly No. 2
40
408
30
Timing chain cover sub-assembly x Cylinder head and block
23
235
17
Oil filter bracket sub-assembly x Timing chain cover sub-assembly
19
194
14
Camshaft timing oil control valve assembly x Timing chain cover subassembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Ignition coil assembly x Cylinder head cover sub-assembly
10
102
7
V-bank cover x Intake air surge tank
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Oil pump relief valve x Oil pump cover
49
500
36
Oil pump cover x Timing chain or belt cover sub-assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil pipe x Timing chain or belt cover and oil pump cover
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil cooler assembly x Oil filter bracket sub-assembly
68
693
50
SS–28
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
at idle speed
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.2 psi) or more
at 3,000 rpm
294 to 588 kPa (3.0 to 6.0 kgf/cm2, 43 to 85 psi)
Oil pump
SS
Tip clearance
Standard
Maximum
Side clearance
Standard
Maximum
Body clearance
Standard
Maximum
0.060 to 0.180 mm (0.0024 to 0.0071 in.)
0.18 mm (0.0071 in.)
0.030 to 0.090 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
0.325 mm (0.0128 in.)
SS–29
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
No. 2 oil pan x Drain plug
Oil pump x Cylinder block
14 mm head
Others
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
39
398
29
31
311
23
16
160
11
Oil pump body cover x Oil pump body
10
105
7
Oil pump relief valve x Oil pump body
49
500
36
Oil cooler x Oil filter bracket
69
700
51
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE IGNITION
SS–29
1GR-FE IGNITION
SERVICE DATA
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
DENSO made
NGK made
K20HR-U11
LFR6C-11
Electrode gap
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
Maximum electrode gap
1.41 mm (0.056 in.)
VVT sensor
Voltage
VVT+ - VVT1-
3.375 to 4.950V (Hi), 0.450 to 1.375V (Lo)
VVT2+ - VVT2-
3.375 to 4.950V (Hi), 0.450 to 1.375V (Lo)
Crankshaft position sensor
Resistance
at Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
at Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
SS
SS–30
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE IGNITION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head
20
204
14
Ignition coil x Cylinder head cover
10
102
7
VVT sensor x Timing chain cover sub-assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
V-bank cover x Intake air surge tank sub-assembly and Air cleaner
assembly
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Crankshaft position sensor x Cylinder block
10
102
7
V-ribbed belt tensioner and Cooler compressor assembly
25
255
18
Engine under cover assembly rear x Frame assembly
29
296
21
SS–30
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE IGNITION
2UZ-FE IGNITION
SERVICE DATA
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
DENSO made
NGK made
SS
SK20R11
1FR6A11
Electrode gap
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
Maximum electrode gap
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
Correct insulation resistance
10 MΩ or more
VVT sensor
Resistance
at Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω
at Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
at Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
at Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
Crankshaft position sensor
Resistance
SS–31
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE IGNITION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head
20
204
15
Ignition coil (with igniter) x Cylinder head cover
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Camshaft position sensor x LH cylinder head
7.5
80
66 in.*lbf
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump
6.5
65
58 in.*lbf
SS
SS–39
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
2UZ-FE:
Part Tightened
Park/neutral position switch
Bolt
Nut
Transmission control cable x Automatic transmission
Engine mounting insulator rear No. 1 x Automatic transmission
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
13
130
9
7
71
62 in.*lbf
12
122
9
65
663
48
17 mm
head
71
720
53
14 mm
head
37
380
27
48
490
35
Flywheel housing under cover x Automatic transmission
18
184
13
Oil cooler tube clamp
5.0
50
43 in.*lbf
Automatic transmission x Engine
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
Oil cooler outlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Oil cooler inlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Oil filler tube
12
122
9
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust pipe
48
490
35
Front suspension member bracket LH x Body
33
336
24
Front suspension member bracket x Body
33
336
24
Speed sensor x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Drain plug x Oil pan
20
204
15
Transmission wire set bolt x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
A
10
100
7
B
11
110
8
Oil strainer x Valve body
10
100
7
Oil pan x Transmission case
4.4
45
39 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S2 x Valve body
10
100
7
Transmission wire clamp x Valve body
Shift solenoid valve SR x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLU, SL2 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLT, SL1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Valve body x Transmission case
11
110
8
Transmission flange x Output shaft
126
1,280
92
Floor shift assembly x Body
12
122
9
Overflow plug x Automatic transmission
20
204
15
Refill plug x Automatic transmission
39
400
29
Frame crossmember sub-assembly No. 3
Bolt & Nut
72
734
53
Bolt
18
184
13
1GR-FE:
Part Tightened
Park/neutral position switch
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Bolt
13
130
9
Nut
6.9
70
61 in.*lbf
14
143
10
Transmission control cable x Automatic transmission
Engine mounting insulator rear No. 1 x Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission x Engine
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
65
663
48
17 mm
head
71
720
53
14 mm
head
37
380
27
48
490
35
SS
SS–40
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Part Tightened
Engine rear mounting member x Body
Nut
Bolt
Transmission control cable bracket No. 1 x Automatic transmission
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
72
735
53
18
184
13
14
143
10
Oil cooler tube clamp
5
51
43 in.*lbf
Oil cooler outlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Oil cooler inlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust pipe
48
490
35
Front suspension member bracket LH x Body
33
336
24
Front suspension member bracket x Body
33
336
24
Speed sensor x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Drain plug x Oil pan
28
285
21
Transmission wire set bolt x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Transmission wire clamp x Valve body
A
11
110
8
B
10
100
7
Oil strainer x Valve body
10
100
7
Oil pan x Transmission case
4.4
45
39 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S2 x Valve body
10
100
7
Shift solenoid valve SR x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLU, SL2 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLT, SL1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Valve body x Transmission case
11
110
8
Floor shift assembly x Body
14
143
10
Overflow plug x Automatic transmission
20
204
15
Refill plug x Automatic transmission
39
400
29
Wire harness x Automatic transmission
8.0
83
71 in.*lbf
Propeller shaft heat insulator x Frame crossmember
33
336
24
Oil cooler assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Transmission control cable assembly x Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
SS–43
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
2UZ-FE:
Part Tightened
Park/neutral position switch
Bolt
Nut
Transmission control cable x Automatic transmission
Engine mounting insulator rear No. 1 x Automatic transmission
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
13
130
9
7
71
62 in.*lbf
12
122
9
65
663
48
17 mm
head
71
720
53
14 mm
head
37
380
27
48
490
35
Flywheel housing under cover x Automatic transmission
18
184
13
Oil cooler tube clamp
5.0
50
43 in.*lbf
Automatic transmission x Engine
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
Oil cooler outlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Oil cooler inlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Oil filler tube
12
122
9
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust pipe
48
490
35
Front suspension member bracket LH x Body
33
336
24
Front suspension member bracket x Body
33
336
24
Speed sensor x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Drain plug x Oil pan
20
204
15
Transmission wire set bolt x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
A
10
100
7
B
11
110
8
Oil strainer x Valve body
10
100
7
Oil pan x Transmission case
4.4
45
39 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S2 x Valve body
10
100
7
Transmission wire clamp x Valve body
Shift solenoid valve SR x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLU, SL2 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLT, SL1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Valve body x Transmission case
11
110
8
Transmission flange x Output shaft
126
1,280
92
Floor shift assembly x Body
12
122
9
Overflow plug x Automatic transmission
20
204
15
Refill plug x Automatic transmission
39
400
29
Frame crossmember sub-assembly No. 3
Bolt & Nut
72
734
53
Bolt
18
184
13
1GR-FE:
Part Tightened
Park/neutral position switch
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Bolt
13
130
9
Nut
6.9
70
61 in.*lbf
14
143
10
Transmission control cable x Automatic transmission
Engine mounting insulator rear No. 1 x Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission x Engine
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
65
663
48
17 mm
head
71
720
53
14 mm
head
37
380
27
48
490
35
SS
SS–44
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Part Tightened
Engine rear mounting member x Body
Nut
Bolt
Transmission control cable bracket No. 1 x Automatic transmission
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
72
735
53
18
184
13
14
143
10
Oil cooler tube clamp
5
51
43 in.*lbf
Oil cooler outlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Oil cooler inlet tube No. 1 x Automatic transmission
34
346
25
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Exhaust pipe x Exhaust pipe
48
490
35
Front suspension member bracket LH x Body
33
336
24
Front suspension member bracket x Body
33
336
24
Speed sensor x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Drain plug x Oil pan
28
285
21
Transmission wire set bolt x Automatic transmission
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Transmission wire clamp x Valve body
A
11
110
8
B
10
100
7
Oil strainer x Valve body
10
100
7
Oil pan x Transmission case
4.4
45
39 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve S2 x Valve body
10
100
7
Shift solenoid valve SR x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLU, SL2 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Shift solenoid valve SLT, SL1 x Valve body
6.4
65
56 in.*lbf
Valve body x Transmission case
11
110
8
Floor shift assembly x Body
14
143
10
Overflow plug x Automatic transmission
20
204
15
Refill plug x Automatic transmission
39
400
29
Wire harness x Automatic transmission
8.0
83
71 in.*lbf
Propeller shaft heat insulator x Frame crossmember
33
336
24
Oil cooler assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Transmission control cable assembly x Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE STARTING
SS–31
1GR-FE STARTING
SERVICE DATA
Starter (1.6 kW type)
Rated voltage and output power
No-load characteristics
12 V 1.6 kW
Current
90 A or less at 11.5 V
Starter armature assembly
Commutator length
Standard
3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
Minimum
3.8 mm (0.150 in.)
Standard
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Minimum
4.0 mm (0.158 in.)
Maximum
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
Starter commutator end frame assembly
Brush holder length
Starter armature assembly
Snap ring length
Starter (2.0 kW type)
Rated voltage and output power
No-load characteristics
12 V 2.0 kW
Current
100 A or less at 11.5 V
Starter armature assembly
Circle runout
Commutator diameter
Undercut depth
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Standard
35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
Minimum
34.0 mm (1.339 in.)
Standard
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Minimum
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
Starter yoke
Shunt coil resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
1.5 to 1.9 Ω
Brush
Brush length
Standard
15.0 mm (0.591 in.)
Minimum
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Starter brush holder assembly
Brush spring load
Standard
21.5 to 27.5 N (2.2 to 2.8 kgf, 4.8 to 6.2 lbf)
Minimum
12.7 N (1.3 kgf, 2.9 lbf)
Starter relay assembly
Specified condition
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
SS
SS–32
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE STARTING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Starter assembly x Transmission housing
37
377
27
Starter assembly x Terminal 30
9.8
100
7
Starter commutator end frame assembly x Starter drive housing
assembly
(Starter Assembly 1.6 kW)
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Starter drive housing assembly x Repair service starter kit
(Starter Assembly 1.6 kW)
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Lead wire x Repair service starter kit
(Starter Assembly 1.6 kW)
10
102
7.4
Commutator end frame x Brush holder
(Starter Assembly 2.0 kW)
3.8
39
34 in.*lbf
Starter drive housing assembly x Magnetic Starter Switch
(Starter Assembly 2.0 kW)
9.3
95
82 in.*lbf
Commutator end frame x Starter drive housing assembly
(Starter Assembly 2.0 kW)
9.3
95
82 in.*lbf
Lead wire x Terminal C of starter
(Starter Assembly 2.0 kW)
5.9
60
52 in.*lbf
Engine wire x Cylinder block
13
133
10
SS–46
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – VF4AM TRANSFER
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf cm
ft*lbf
Transfer case lower protector x Transfer
18
184
13
Transfer x Transfer adaptor
24
240
17
Front bearing retainer sub-assembly x Front case
SS
11.5
117
8
Transfer case cover sub-assembly x Front case
18
185
13
Output shaft companion flange sub-assembly lock nut
118
1,200
87
Extension housing sub-assembly rear x Case rear
12
120
9
Front case x Case rear
28
285
21
Gear shift fork No. 2 x Transfer shift actuator assembly
24
245
18
Shift shaft stopper x Case rear
19
195
14
CTR differential lock fork sub-assembly x Transfer shift actuator
assembly
24
245
18
Transfer shift actuator assembly x Case rear
20
200
14
Case No. 1 plug (Filler plug) x Case rear
37
380
27
Case No. 1 plug (Drain plug) x Case rear
37
380
27
Oil separator sub-assembly x Case rear
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Oil separator sub-assembly x Case rear
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Transfer case plug x Front case
18.6
190
14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE STARTING
SS–33
2UZ-FE STARTING
SERVICE DATA
Rated voltage and output power
No-load characteristics
Brush length
Spring installed load
Starter
(1.4 kW type)
12 V 1.4 kW
Current
Standard
15.5 mm (0.610 in.)
Minimum
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Standard
17.6 to 23.5 N (1.8 to 2.4 kgf, 4.0 to 5.3 lbf)
Minimum
11.8 N (1.20 kgf, 2.7 lbf)
Standard
30.0 mm (1.181 in.)
Minimum
29.0 mm (1.142 in.)
Standard
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Minimum
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Commutator
Diameter
Undercut depth
Circle runout
Rated voltage and output power
No-load characteristics
Brush length
Spring installed load
Starter
(2.0 kW type)
90 A or less at 11.5 V
12 V 2.0 kW
Current
100 A or less at 11.5 V
Standard
15.0 mm (0.591 in.)
Minimum
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Standard
21.5 to 27.5 N (2.2 to 2.8 kgf, 4.8 to 6.2 lbf)
Minimum
12.7 N (1.3 kgf, 2.9 lbf)
Standard
35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
Minimum
34.0 mm (1.339 in.)
Standard
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Minimum
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Commutator
Diameter
Undercut depth
Circle runout
Field frame
Shunt coil resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
1.5 to 1.9 Ω
SS
SS–34
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE STARTING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
End cover x Brush holder
Starter hosing x Magnetic switch
End cover with field frame x Magnetic switch
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
1.4 kW type
1.5
15
13 in.*lbf
2.0 kW type
3.8
39
34 in.*lbf
1.4 kW type
5.9
60
52 in.*lbf
2.0 kW type
9.3
95
82 in.*lbf
1.4 kW type
5.9
60
52 in.*lbf
2.0 kW type
9.3
95
82 in.*lbf
Lead wire of field coil x Terminal C
5.9
60
52 in.*lbf
Wire clamp, Starter wire x Starter
9.8
100
86 in.*lbf
Starter x Cylinder block
39
400
29
SS–48
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – VF4BM TRANSFER
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf cm
ft*lbf
Transfer case lower protector x Transfer
18
184
13
Transfer x Transfer adaptor
24
240
17
Front bearing retainer sub-assembly x Front case
SS
11.5
117
8
Transfer case cover sub-assembly x Front case
18
185
13
Output shaft companion flange sub-assembly lock nut
118
1,200
87
Extension housing sub-assembly rear x Case rear
12
120
9
Front case x Case rear
28
285
21
Gear shift fork No. 2 x Transfer shift actuator assembly
24
245
18
CTR differential lock fork sub-assembly x Transfer shift actuator
assembly
24
245
18
Transfer shift actuator assembly x Case rear
20
200
14
Case No. 1 plug (Filler plug) x Case rear
37
380
27
Case No. 1 plug (Drain plug) x Case rear
37
380
27
Oil separator sub-assembly x Case rear
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Oil separator sub-assembly x Case rear
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Transfer case plug x Front case
18.6
190
14
SS–34
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE CHARGING
1GR-FE CHARGING
SERVICE DATA
ACC relay
Specified condition
SS
1-2
Continuity
3-4
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
Battery
Voltage
Except maintenance-free battery
at 20°C (68°F)
Standard specific gravity
12.5 to 12.9 V
1.25 to 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
Voltage regulator
Regulating voltage
13.2 to 14.8 V
Generator brush holder assembly
Brush length
Standard
10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum
4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
Generator rotor assembly
Resistance
Slip ring diameter
at 20°C (68°F)
2.3 to 2.7 Ω
Standard
14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum
14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
SS–35
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1GR-FE CHARGING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Manifold stay x Transmission housing and Exhaust manifold
40
408
30
Steering sliding yoke x Steering intermediate shaft No. 2
36
370
27
Generator assembly x V-ribbed belt tensioner and cylinder head
43
438
32
Generator assembly x Wire harness clamp bracket
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Generator assembly x Terminal B
9.8
100
7
Wire harness stay x Body
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
V-bank cover x Intake air surge tank sub-assembly and Air cleaner
assembly
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1 x Frame assembly
29
296
21
Engine under cover assembly rear x Frame assembly
29
296
21
Retainer plate x Drive end frame assembly generator
2.6
27
23 in.*lbf
Generator coil assembly x Drive frame assembly generator
5.8
59
51 in.*lbf
Generator brush holder assembly x Generator coil assembly
1.8
18
16 in.*lbf
Generator rear end cover x Generator coil assembly
4.6
47
41 in.*lbf
Generator pulley x Generator rotor assembly
110
1,122
81
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE CHARGING
SS–35
2UZ-FE CHARGING
SERVICE DATA
Battery
Maintenance-free
Voltage
at 20°C (68°F)
Rated output
Rotor coil resistance
Generator
Slip ring diameter
Brush exposed length
Voltage regulator
Regulating voltage
12.5 to 12.9 V
12 V 100 A
at 20°C (68°F)
2.3 to 2.7 Ω
Standard
14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum
14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
Standard
10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum
4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
13.2 to 14.0 V
SS
SS–36
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 2UZ-FE CHARGING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Water by-pass joint RR x Cylinder head
18
185
13
Water by-pass pipe x Water pump
18
185
13
Bolt
18
185
13
Nut
18
185
13
Bearing retainer x Drive end frame
2.6
2.7
23 in.*lbf
Rectifier end frame x Drive end frame
5.8
59
51 in.*lbf
110.5
1,125
81
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
SS
Generator pulley x Rotor
SS–36
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
A750E AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
SERVICE DATA
2UZ-FE:
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
SS
D position
362 to 423 kPa (3.7 to 4.3 kgf*cm2, 53 to 61 psi)
R position
495 to 576 kPa (5.0 to 5.9 kgf*cm2, 71 to 84 psi)
AT stall (Throttle valve fully open)
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
D position
1,235 to 1,332 kPa (12.6 to 13.6 kgf*cm2, 179 to 193 psi)
R position
1,229 to 1,350 kPa (12.5 to 13.8 kgf*cm2, 178 to 196 psi)
D position
2,200 +- 150 rpm
N → D position
Less than 1.2 seconds
N → R position
Less than 1.5 seconds
N position
Drive plate runout
Max.
Torque converter runout
Max.
Torque converter clutch installation distance
700 +- 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
More than 17.1 mm (0.673 in.)
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully open)
(Throttle valve fully close)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
2→3
97 to 108 km/h (60 to 67 mph)
3→4
138 to 154 km/h (86 to 96 mph)
4→5
186 to 200 km/h (116 to 124 mph)
5→4
181 to 194 km/h (112 to 121 mph)
4→3
126 to 139 km/h (78 to 86 mph)
3→2
85 to 93 km/h (53 to 58 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
4→5
50 to 56 km/h (31 to 35 mph)
5→4
26 to 31 km/h (16 to 19 mph)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
4 position
(Throttle valve fully close)
2→3
97 to 108 km/h (60 to 67 mph)
3→4
138 to 154 km/h (86 to 96 mph)
5→4
198 to 212 km/h (122 to 132 mph)
4→3
126 to 139 km/h (78 to 86 mph)
3→2
85 to 93 km/h (53 to 58 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
3 position
(Throttle valve fully open)
2 position
2→3
97 to 108 km/h (60 to 67 mph)
4→3
139 to 151 km/h (86 to 94 mph)
3→2
85 to 93 km/h (53 to 58 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
(Throttle valve fully open)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
3→2
92 to 103 km/h (57 to 64 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
SS–37
L position
(Throttle valve fully open)
Lock-up point
Throttle valve opening 5%
D position
5th gear
Lock-up ON 72 to 79 km/h (45 to 49 mph)
Lock-up OFF
65 to 71 km/h (40 to 44 mph)
4 position
4th gear
Lock-up ON 117 to 125 km/h (73 to 78 mph)
Lock-up OFF
110 to 117 km/h (68 to 73 mph)
1GR-FE:
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
362 to 423 kPa (3.7 to 4.3 kgf*cm2, 53 to 61 psi)
R position
484 to 565 kPa (4.9 to 5.8 kgf*cm2, 70 to 82 psi)
AT stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
D position
1,282 to 1,381 kPa (13.1 to 14.1 kgf*cm2, 186 to 200 psi)
R position
1,218 to 1,338 kPa (12.4 to 13.6 kgf*cm2, 177 to 194 psi)
D positions
2,400 +- 150 rpm
N → D position
Less than 1.2 seconds
N → R position
Less than 1.5 seconds
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
N position
Drive plate runout
Max.
Torque converter runout
Max.
Torque converter clutch installation distance
700 +- 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
More than 17.1 mm (0.673 in.)
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully open)
(Throttle valve fully close)
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
2→3
97 to 106 km/h (60 to 66 mph)
3→4
140 to 154 km/h (87 to 96 mph)
4→5
179 to 189 km/h (111 to 117 mph)
5→4
171 to 182 km/h (106 to 113 mph)
4→3
125 to 134 km/h (78 to 83 mph)
3→2
83 to 89 km/h (52 to 55 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
4→5
46 to 51 km/h (29 to 32 mph)
5→4
27 to 33 km/h (17 to 21 mph)
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
2→3
97 to 106 km/h (60 to 66 mph)
3→4
140 to 154 km/h (87 to 96 mph)
5→4
191 to 202 km/h (119 to 126 mph)
4→3
125 to 134 km/h (78 to 83 mph)
3→2
83 to 89 km/h (52 to 55 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
4 position
(Throttle valve fully open)
3 position
SS
SS–38
(Throttle valve fully open)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
2→3
97 to 106 km/h (60 to 66 mph)
4→3
133 to 143 km/h (83 to 88 mph)
3→2
83 to 89 km/h (52 to 55 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
2 position
(Throttle valve fully open)
SS
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
3→2
88 to 98 km/h (55 to 61 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
2→1
42 to 48 km/h (26 to 30 mph)
L position
(Throttle valve fully open)
Lock-up point
Throttle valve opening 5%
D position
5th gear
Lock-up ON
57 to 63 km/h (35 to 39 mph)
Lock-up OFF
50 to 55 km/h (31 to 34 mph)
Lock-up ON
69 to 74 km/h (43 to 46 mph)
Lock-up OFF
61 to 67 km/h (38 to 42 mph)
4 position
4th gear
SS–40
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
A750F AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
SERVICE DATA
2UZ-FE:
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
SS
D position
362 to 423 kPa (3.7 to 4.3 kgf*cm2, 53 to 61 psi)
R position
495 to 576 kPa (5.0 to 5.9 kgf*cm2, 71 to 84 psi)
AT stall (Throttle valve fully open)
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
D position
1,235 to 1,332 kPa (12.6 to 13.6 kgf*cm2, 179 to 193 psi)
R position
1,229 to 1,350 kPa (12.5 to 13.8 kgf*cm2, 178 to 196 psi)
D position
2,200 +- 150 rpm
N → D position
Less than 1.2 seconds
N → R position
Less than 1.5 seconds
N position
Drive plate runout
Max.
Torque converter runout
Max.
Torque converter clutch installation distance
700 +- 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
More than 17.1 mm (0.673 in.)
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully open)
(Throttle valve fully close)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
2→3
97 to 108 km/h (60 to 67 mph)
3→4
138 to 154 km/h (86 to 96 mph)
4→5
186 to 200 km/h (116 to 124 mph)
5→4
181 to 194 km/h (112 to 121 mph)
4→3
126 to 139 km/h (78 to 86 mph)
3→2
85 to 93 km/h (53 to 58 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
4→5
50 to 56 km/h (31 to 35 mph)
5→4
26 to 31 km/h (16 to 19 mph)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
4 position
(Throttle valve fully close)
2→3
97 to 108 km/h (60 to 67 mph)
3→4
138 to 154 km/h (86 to 96 mph)
5→4
198 to 212 km/h (122 to 132 mph)
4→3
126 to 139 km/h (78 to 86 mph)
3→2
85 to 93 km/h (53 to 58 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
3 position
(Throttle valve fully open)
2 position
2→3
97 to 108 km/h (60 to 67 mph)
4→3
139 to 151 km/h (86 to 94 mph)
3→2
85 to 93 km/h (53 to 58 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
(Throttle valve fully open)
1→2
52 to 64 km/h (32 to 40 mph)
3→2
92 to 103 km/h (57 to 64 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
2→1
40 to 46 km/h (25 to 29 mph)
SS–41
L position
(Throttle valve fully open)
Lock-up point
Throttle valve opening 5%
D position
5th gear
Lock-up ON 72 to 79 km/h (45 to 49 mph)
Lock-up OFF
65 to 71 km/h (40 to 44 mph)
4 position
4th gear
Lock-up ON 117 to 125 km/h (73 to 78 mph)
Lock-up OFF
110 to 117 km/h (68 to 73 mph)
1GR-FE:
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
362 to 423 kPa (3.7 to 4.3 kgf*cm2, 53 to 61 psi)
R position
484 to 565 kPa (4.9 to 5.8 kgf*cm2, 70 to 82 psi)
AT stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
D position
1,282 to 1,381 kPa (13.1 to 14.1 kgf*cm2, 186 to 200 psi)
R position
1,218 to 1,338 kPa (12.4 to 13.6 kgf*cm2, 177 to 194 psi)
D positions
2,400 +- 150 rpm
N → D position
Less than 1.2 seconds
N → R position
Less than 1.5 seconds
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
N position
Drive plate runout
Max.
Torque converter runout
Max.
Torque converter clutch installation distance
700 +- 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
More than 17.1 mm (0.673 in.)
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully open)
(Throttle valve fully close)
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
2→3
97 to 106 km/h (60 to 66 mph)
3→4
140 to 154 km/h (87 to 96 mph)
4→5
179 to 189 km/h (111 to 117 mph)
5→4
171 to 182 km/h (106 to 113 mph)
4→3
125 to 134 km/h (78 to 83 mph)
3→2
83 to 89 km/h (52 to 55 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
4→5
46 to 51 km/h (29 to 32 mph)
5→4
27 to 33 km/h (17 to 21 mph)
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
2→3
97 to 106 km/h (60 to 66 mph)
3→4
140 to 154 km/h (87 to 96 mph)
5→4
191 to 202 km/h (119 to 126 mph)
4→3
125 to 134 km/h (78 to 83 mph)
3→2
83 to 89 km/h (52 to 55 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
4 position
(Throttle valve fully open)
3 position
SS
SS–42
(Throttle valve fully open)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – A750F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
2→3
97 to 106 km/h (60 to 66 mph)
4→3
133 to 143 km/h (83 to 88 mph)
3→2
83 to 89 km/h (52 to 55 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
2 position
(Throttle valve fully open)
SS
1→2
50 to 61 km/h (31 to 38 mph)
3→2
88 to 98 km/h (55 to 61 mph)
2→1
39 to 44 km/h (24 to 27 mph)
2→1
42 to 48 km/h (26 to 30 mph)
L position
(Throttle valve fully open)
Lock-up point
Throttle valve opening 5%
D position
5th gear
Lock-up ON
57 to 63 km/h (35 to 39 mph)
Lock-up OFF
50 to 55 km/h (31 to 34 mph)
Lock-up ON
69 to 74 km/h (43 to 46 mph)
Lock-up OFF
61 to 67 km/h (38 to 42 mph)
4 position
4th gear
SS–44
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – VF4AM TRANSFER
VF4AM TRANSFER
SERVICE DATA
Output shaft rear
Drive sprocket thrust clearance
Drive sprocket radial clearance
SS
STD
0.15 to 0.24 mm (0.0059 to 0.0094 in.)
Max.
0.24 mm (0.0094 in.)
STD
0.01 to 0.06 mm (0.0004 to 0.0024 in.)
Max.
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Gear shift fork No. 2 claw thickness
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
High and low clutch sleeve groove distance
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
Gear shift fork No. 2 to high and low clutch sleeve clearance
STD
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Max.
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
CTR differential lock fork claw thickness
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
Front drive clutch sleeve groove distance
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
CTR differential lock fork to front drive clutch sleeve clearance
STD
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Max.
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
Rear output shaft journal outer diameter
Part A
Part B
Part C
STD
27.98 to 27.99 mm (1.1016 to 1.1020 in.)
Min.
27.98 mm (1.1016 in.)
STD
31.98 to 32.00 mm (1.2591 to 1.2598 in.)
Min.
31.98 mm (1.2591 in.)
STD
34.98 to 35.00 mm (1.3772 to 1.3780 in.)
Min.
34.98 mm (1.3772 in.)
STD
36.98 to 37.00 mm (1.4559 to 1.4567 in.)
Min.
36.98 mm (1.4559 in.)
Input shaft journal outer diameter
Min.
47.59 mm (1.8736 in.)
Input shaft bushing diameter
Max.
48.14 mm (1.8953 in.)
Part D
Input shaft
Mark
A
Input gear stopper snap ring thickness
2.10 to 2.15 mm (0.0827 to 0.0846 in.)
B
2.15 to 2.20 mm (0.0846 to 0.0866 in.)
C
2.20 to 2.25 mm (0.0866 to 0.0886 in.)
D
2.25 to 2.30 mm (0.0886 to 0.0906 in.)
E
2.30 to 2.35 mm (0.0906 to 0.0925 in.)
F
2.35 to 2.40 mm (0.0925 to 0.0945 in.)
G
2.40 to 2.45 mm (0.0945 to 0.0965 in.)
H
2.45 to 2.50 mm (0.0965 to 0.0984 in.)
J
2.50 to 2.55 mm (0.0984 to 0.1004 in.)
K
2.55 to 2.60 mm (0.1004 to 0.1024 in.)
L
2.60 to 2.65 mm (0.1024 to 0.1043 in.)
M
2.65 to 2.70 mm (0.1043 to 0.1063 in.)
N
2.70 to 2.75 mm (0.1063 to 0.1083 in.)
P
2.75 to 2.80 mm (0.1083 to 0.1102 in.)
Q
2.80 to 2.85 mm (0.1102 to 0.1122 in.)
R
2.85 to 2.90 mm (0.1122 to 0.1142 in.)
S
2.90 to 2.95 mm (0.1142 to 0.1161 in.)
T
2.95 to 3.00 mm (0.1161 to 0.1181 in.)
U
3.00 to 3.05 mm (0.1181 to 0.1201 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – VF4AM TRANSFER
SS–45
Planetary gear
STD
Pinion gear thrust clearance
Pinion gear radial clearance
0.11 to 0.84 mm (0.0043 to 0.0331 in.)
Max.
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
STD
0.009 to 0.038 mm (0.0004 to 0.0015 in.)
Max.
0.038 mm (0.0015 in.)
Mark
Input bearing shaft snap ring thickness
Low planetary gear bearing press in depth
1
1.45 to 1.50 mm (0.0571 to 0.0591 in.)
2
1.50 to 1.55 mm (0.0591 to 0.0610 in.)
3
1.55 to 1.60 mm (0.0610 to 0.0630 in.)
4
1.60 to 1.65 mm (0.0630 to 0.0650 in.)
5
1.65 to 1.70 mm (0.0650 to 0.0669 in.)
7.7 to 8.3 mm (0.303 to 0.327 in.)
SS
SS–46
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – VF4BM TRANSFER
VF4BM TRANSFER
SERVICE DATA
Output shaft rear
Drive sprocket thrust clearance
Drive sprocket radial clearance
SS
STD
0.15 to 0.24 mm (0.0059 to 0.0094 in.)
Max.
0.24 mm (0.0094 in.)
STD
0.01 to 0.06 mm (0.0004 to 0.0024 in.)
Max.
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Gear shift fork No. 2 claw thickness
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
High and low clutch sleeve groove distance
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
Gear shift fork No. 2 to high and low clutch sleeve clearance
STD
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Max.
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
CTR differential lock fork claw thickness
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
Front drive clutch sleeve groove distance
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
CTR differential lock fork to front drive clutch sleeve clearance
STD
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Max.
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
Rear output shaft journal outer diameter
Part A
Part B
Part C
STD
27.98 to 27.99 mm (1.1016 to 1.1020 in.)
Min.
27.98 mm (1.1016 in.)
STD
31.98 to 32.00 mm (1.2591 to 1.2598 in.)
Min.
31.98 mm (1.2591 in.)
STD
34.98 to 35.00 mm (1.3772 to 1.3780 in.)
Min.
34.98 mm (1.3772 in.)
STD
36.98 to 37.00 mm (1.4559 to 1.4567 in.)
Min.
36.98 mm (1.4559 in.)
Input shaft journal outer diameter
Min.
47.59 mm (1.8736 in.)
Input shaft bushing diameter
Max.
48.14 mm (1.8953 in.)
Part D
Input shaft
Mark
A
Input gear stopper snap ring thickness
2.10 to 2.15 mm (0.0827 to 0.0846 in.)
B
2.15 to 2.20 mm (0.0846 to 0.0866 in.)
C
2.20 to 2.25 mm (0.0866 to 0.0886 in.)
D
2.25 to 2.30 mm (0.0886 to 0.0906 in.)
E
2.30 to 2.35 mm (0.0906 to 0.0925 in.)
F
2.35 to 2.40 mm (0.0925 to 0.0945 in.)
G
2.40 to 2.45 mm (0.0945 to 0.0965 in.)
H
2.45 to 2.50 mm (0.0965 to 0.0984 in.)
J
2.50 to 2.55 mm (0.0984 to 0.1004 in.)
K
2.55 to 2.60 mm (0.1004 to 0.1024 in.)
L
2.60 to 2.65 mm (0.1024 to 0.1043 in.)
M
2.65 to 2.70 mm (0.1043 to 0.1063 in.)
N
2.70 to 2.75 mm (0.1063 to 0.1083 in.)
P
2.75 to 2.80 mm (0.1083 to 0.1102 in.)
Q
2.80 to 2.85 mm (0.1102 to 0.1122 in.)
R
2.85 to 2.90 mm (0.1122 to 0.1142 in.)
S
2.90 to 2.95 mm (0.1142 to 0.1161 in.)
T
2.95 to 3.00 mm (0.1161 to 0.1181 in.)
U
3.00 to 3.05 mm (0.1181 to 0.1201 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – VF4BM TRANSFER
SS–47
Planetary gear
STD
Pinion gear thrust clearance
Pinion gear radial clearance
0.11 to 0.84 mm (0.0043 to 0.0331 in.)
Max.
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
STD
0.009 to 0.038 mm (0.0004 to 0.0015 in.)
Max.
0.038 mm (0.0015 in.)
Mark
Input bearing shaft snap ring thickness
Low planetary gear bearing press in depth
1
1.45 to 1.50 mm (0.0571 to 0.0591 in.)
2
1.50 to 1.55 mm (0.0591 to 0.0610 in.)
3
1.55 to 1.60 mm (0.0610 to 0.0630 in.)
4
1.60 to 1.65 mm (0.0630 to 0.0650 in.)
5
1.65 to 1.70 mm (0.0650 to 0.0669 in.)
7.7 to 8.3 mm (0.303 to 0.327 in.)
SS
SS–48
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – PROPELLER SHAFT
PROPELLER SHAFT
SERVICE DATA
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
Propeller shaft runout
Maximum:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
Universal joint spider bearing axial play
Maximum:
0 mm (0 in.)
Maximum:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
SS
Propeller shaft runout
SS–49
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – PROPELLER SHAFT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
88
897
65
88
897
65
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
Propeller shaft flange yoke x Companion flange
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Propeller shaft x Companion flange
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DRIVE SHAFT
SS–49
DRIVE SHAFT
SERVICE DATA
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY
Front axle hub backlash
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Front axle hub deviation
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle shaft backlash
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle shaft deviation
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle shaft runout
Maximum:
1.5 mm (0.0591 in.)
Rear axle shaft flange runout
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
REAR AXLE SHAFT LH
SS
SS–50
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DRIVE SHAFT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front axle hub assembly x Lock nut
235
2,396
173
Steering knuckle x Tie rod end
91
928
67
Steering knuckle x Stabilizer link
70
714
52
Disc brake caliper x Steering knuckle
123
1,254
91
Disc brake caliper x Brake tube
15
155
11
Front brake tube bracket set bolt
26
296
21
ABS speed sensor wire harness bracket set bolt
13
133
10
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
SS
ABS speed sensor set bolt
8.3
85
73 in.*lbf
Steering knuckle x Upper ball joint
110
1,122
81
Steering knuckle x Lower ball joint
160
1,630
118
Steering knuckle x Front axle w/ ABS rotor bearing assembly
80
816
59
Front wheel adjusting nut x Front axle w/ ABS rotor bearing assembly
275
2,804
203
Front wheel
112
1,142
83
123
1,254
91
Rear axle shaft w/ backing plate x Disc brake caliper
47
480
35
ABS speed sensor set nut
8.3
85
73 in.*lbf
REAR AXLE SHAFT
Axle housing x Rear axle shaft
Rear brake tube x Master cylinder
15
155
11
Rear wheel
112
1,142
83
SS–54
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DIFFERENTIAL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Differential carrier assembly front (4WD)
Companion flange x Drive pinion
SS
See page DF-12, DF-35
Propeller shaft x Companion flange
88
897
65
Differential front mounting support No. 1 x Frame
137
1,400
101
Differential front mounting support No. 2 x Frame
137
1,400
101
Differential front mounting support No. 2 x Front differential tube
assembly
160
1,630
118
Differential front mounting support No. 1 x Differential carrier
assembly front
186
1,900
137
Differential front mounting support No. 2 x Differential carrier
assembly front
145
1,479
107
Differential front mounting support No. 3 x Differential carrier
assembly front
108
1,100
80
Front differential mount nut No. 1
87
887
64
Ring gear x Differential case
97
985
71
Differential carrier assembly front x Breather tube
13
133
10
Differential carrier assembly front x Side bearing retainer
50
510
37
Differential carrier assembly front x Differential case
110
1,122
81
Drain plug
65
660
48
Filler plug
39
400
29
Front wheel
112
1,142
83
Differential carrier assembly rear
Companion flange x Drive pinion
See page DF-53
Rear axle housing x Backing plate
66
670
48
Propeller shaft x Companion flange
88
897
65
Differential carrier assembly rear x Rear axle housing
20
204
15
Differential carrier assembly rear x Bearing cap
85
867
63
Differential case x Ring gear
97
985
71
Bearing cap x adjusting nut lock
13
130
9
10
101
7.3
47
480
35
Companion flange x Stud bolt
2WD Drive Type:
Differential RH case x Differential LH case
Differential vacuum actuator assembly x Front differential tube
assembly
1GR-FE (4WD)
Drain plug
21
210
15
49
500
36
Filler plug
49
500
36
Rear wheel
112
1,142
83
SS–59
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Tie rod end lock nut
88
897
65
Shock absorber piston rod x Suspension support sub-assembly
25
260
18
Shock absorber (upper) x Frame
64
650
47
Shock absorber (Reas) bracket x Frame
29
300
21
Stabilizer link x Steering knuckle
70
710
52
Hub nut
112
1,140
83
Shock absorber x Lower arm
135
1,380
100
Upper arm x Steering knuckle arm
110
1,120
81
Skid control sensor x Upper arm
13
130
9 ft*lbf
Upper arm x Body
115
1,170
85
Lower arm x Suspension cross member
135
1,380
100
Lower arm x Lower ball joint attachment
140
1,430
103
Lower ball joint attachment x Steering knuckle arm
160
1,630
118
Stabilizer bracket x Body
40
410
30
Shock absorber x Body
25
255
18
Hub nut
112
1137
83
Shock absorber x Rear axle housing
98
1000
72
Shock absorber bracket (REAS) x Fram
29
296
21
Brake tube x Brake hose
15
155
11
Upper control arm x Rear axle housing
80
816
59
Upper control arm x Fram
80
816
59
Lower control arm x Rear axle housing
130
1326
96
Lower control arm x Fram
130
1326
96
Lower control arm x Parking brake cable
13
127
9
Lateral control rod x Rear axle housing
130
1326
96
Lateral control rod x Fram
130
1326
96
Stabilizer bar x Stabilizer link
70
714
52
Stabilizer bar x Rear axle housing
30
306
22
Stabilizer link x Fram
15
153
11
Center control absorber (REAS) x Fram
29
296
21
Center control absorber bracket (REAS) x Fram
29
296
21
Tube protector (REAS) x Fram
29
296
21
Center control absorber tube (REAS) x Fram
29
296
21
SS
SS–50
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL
SERVICE DATA
Differential carrier assembly front (1GR-FE (4WD))
Differential drive pinion preload (at starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
Total preload (at starting)
SS
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (10 to 16 kgf*cm, 8.7 to 13.9 in.*lbf)
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to 6.9 in.*lbf)
Drive pinion preload plus
0.20 to 0.63 N*m (2.0 to 6.4 kgf*cm, 1.8 to 5.6 in.*lbf)
Differential ring gear backlash
0.11 to 0.18 mm (0.0043 to 0.0071 in.)
Differential side gear backlash
0 to 0.15 mm (0 to 0.00591 in.)
Front differential carrier oil seal
Oil seal drive in depth
4.35 +- 0.45 mm (0.171 +- 0.018 in.)
Oil seal drive in depth
0 +- 0.45 mm (0 +- 0.0177 in.)
Oil seal drive in depth
5.3 +- 0.5 mm (0.2087 +- 0.0197 in.)
Front differential side oil seal
Front differential side tube oil seal
Front differential side gear needle roller bearing
Bearing press in depth
1.7 +- 0.3 mm (0.067 +- 0.012 in.)
Differential clutch sleeve and clutch sleeve fork clearance
Max.
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Differential carrier assembly front (2UZ-FE (4WD))
Companion flange vertical runout
Max.
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Differential drive pinion preload (at starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (10 to 16 kgf*cm, 8.7 to 14 in.*lbf)
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to 6.9 in.*lbf)
Total preload (at starting)
Drive pinion preload plus
0.25 to 0.45 N*m (2.5 to 4.6 kgf*cm, 2.2 to 4.0 in.*lbf)
Differential ring gear backlash
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
Differential case runout
Max
Side gear backlash
0.04 mm (0.0018 in.)
0 to 0.15 mm (0 to 0.00591 in.)
Front differential carrier oil seal
Oil seal drive in depth
4.35 +- 0.45 mm (0.171 +- 0.018 in.)
Oil seal drive in depth
0 +- 0.3 mm (0 +- 0.012 in.)
Front differential side oil seal
Front differential side tube oil seal
Oil seal drive in depth
5.3 +- 0.5 mm (0.209 +- 0.020 in.)
Differential side gear backlash
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.002 to 0.008 in.)
Differential ring gear backlash
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
Differential carrier assembly front (4WD)
Companion flange lateral runout
Max.
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DIFFERENTIAL
SS–51
1.48 to 1.52 mm (0.0583 to 0.0598 in.)
1.53 to 1.57 mm (0.0602 to 0.0618 in.)
1.58 to 1.62 mm (0.0622 to 0.0638 in.)
1.63 to 1.67 mm (0.0642 to 0.0657 in.)
Front differential side gear thrust washer thickness
1.68 to 1.72 mm (0.0661 to 0.0677 in.)
1.73 to 1.77 mm (0.0681 to 0.0697 in.)
1.78 to1.82 mm (0.0701 to 0.0717 in.)
1.83 to 1.87 mm (0.0720 to 0.0736 in.)
1.88 to1.92 mm (0.0740 to 0.0756 in.)
1.59 to 1.61 mm (0.0626 to 0.0634 in.)
1.62 to 1.64 mm (0.0638 to 0.0646 in.)
1.65 to 1.67 mm (0.0650 to 0.0657 in.)
1.68 to 1.70 mm (0.0661 to 0.0669 in.)
1.71 to 1.73 mm (0.0673 to 0.0681 in.)
1.74 to 1.76 mm (0.0685 to 0.0693 in.)
1.77 to 1.79 mm (0.0697 to 0.0705 in.)
1.80 to 1.82 mm (0.0709 to 0.0717 in.)
1.83 to 1.85 mm (0.0720 to 0.0728 in.)
1.86 to 1.88 mm (0.0732 to 0.0740 in.)
1.89 to 1.91 mm (0.0744 to 0.0752 in.)
1.92 to 1.94 mm (0.0756 to 0.0764 in.)
1.95 to 1.97 mm (0.0768 to 0.0776 in.)
1.98 to 2.00 mm (0.0780 to 0.0787 in.)
Front differential ring gear thrust washer thickness
2.01 to 2.03 mm (0.0791 to 0.0800 in.)
2.04 to 2.06 mm (0.0803 to 0.0811 in.)
2.07 to 2.09 mm (0.0815 to 0.0823 in.)
2.10 to 2.12 mm (0.0827 to 0.0835 in.)
2.13 to 2.15 mm (0.0839 to 0.0846 in.)
2.16 to 2.18 mm (0.0850 to 0.0858 in.)
2.19 to 2.21 mm (0.0862 to 0.0870 in.)
2.22 to 2.24 mm (0.0874 to 0.0882 in.)
2.25 to 2.27 mm (0.0886 to 0.0894 in.)
2.28 to 2.30 mm (0.0898 to 0.0906 in.)
2.31 to 2.33 mm (0.0909 to 0.0917 in.)
2.34 to 2.36 mm (0.0921 to 0.0929 in.)
2.37 to 2.39 mm (0.0933 to 0.0941 in.)
2.40 to 2.42 mm (0.0945 to 0.0953 in.)
2.43 to 2.45 mm (0.0957 to 0.0965 in.)
2.46 to 2.48 mm (0.0969 to 0.0976 in.)
SS
SS–52
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DIFFERENTIAL
1.69 to 1.71 mm (0.0665 to 0.0673 in.)
1.72 to 1.74 mm (0.0677 to 0.0685 in.)
1.75 to 1.77 mm (0.0689 to 0.0697 in.)
1.78 to 1.80 mm (0.0701 to 0.0709 in.)
1.81 to 1.83 mm (0.0713 to 0.0720 in.)
1.84 to 1.86 mm (0.0724 to 0.0732 in.)
1.87 to 1.89 mm (0.0736 to 0.0744 in.)
1.90 to 1.92 mm (0.0748 to 0.0756 in.)
1.93 to 1.95 mm (0.0760 to 0.0768 in.)
SS
1.96 to 1.98 mm (0.0772 to 0.0780 in.)
1.99 to 2.01 mm (0.0783 to 0.0791 in.)
Rear differential drive pinion plate washer thickness
2.02 to 2.04 mm (0.0795 to 0.0803 in.)
2.05 to 2.07 mm (0.0807 to 0.0815 in.)
2.08 to 2.10 mm (0.0819 to 0.0827 in.)
2.11 to 2.13 mm (0.0831 to 0.0839 in.)
2.14 to 2.16 mm (0.0843 to 0.0850 in.)
2.17 to 2.19 mm (0.0854 to 0.0862 in.)
2.20 to 2.22 mm (0.0866 to 0.0874 in.)
2.23 to 2.25 mm (0.0878 to 0.0886 in.)
2.26 to 2.28 mm (0.0890 to 0.0898 in.)
2.29 to 2.31 mm (0.0902 to 0.0909 in.)
2.32 to 2.34 mm (0.0913 to 0.0921 in.)
Differential carrier assembly rear
Companion flange vertical runout
Max
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Max
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Max
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Max
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Companion flange lateral runout
Differential ring gear runout
Rear differential case runout
Differential drive pinion preload (at starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
1.05 to 1.64 N*m (10.7 to 16.7 kgf*cm, 9.3 to 14.5 in.*lbf)
0.56 to 0.85 N*m (5.7 to 8.7 kgf*cm, 5.0 to 7.5 in.*lbf)
Drive pinion preload plus
0.39 to 0.59 N*m (4.0 to 6.0 kgf*cm, 3.5 to 5.2 in.*lbf)
Total preload (at starting)
Differential ring gear backlash
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
Rear differential case side gear backlash LH
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0002 to 0.008 in.)
Rear differential case side gear backlash RH
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0002 to 0.008 in.)
Rear differential carrier oil seal
Oil seal drive in depth
0.7 +- 1.3 mm (0.0276 +- 0.0512 in.)
0.9 mm (0.0354 in.)
1.0 mm (0.0394 in.)
Rear differential side gear thrust washer thickness
1.1 mm (0.0433 in.)
1.2 mm (0.0472 in.)
1.3 mm (0.0512 in.)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DIFFERENTIAL
SS–53
Differential carrier assembly rear
1.70 mm (0.0669 in.)
1.73 mm (0.0681 in.)
1.76 mm (0.0693 in.)
1.79 mm (0.0705 in.)
1.82 mm (0.0717 in.)
1.85 mm (0.0728 in.)
1.88 mm (0.0740 in.)
1.91 mm (0.0752 in.)
1.94 mm (0.0764 in.)
1.97 mm (0.0776 in.)
Rear differential drive pinion plate washer thickness
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
2.03 mm (0.0799 in.)
2.06 mm (0.0811 in.)
2.09 mm (0.0823 in.)
2.12 mm (0.0835 in.)
2.15 mm (0.0846 in.)
2.18 mm (0.0858 in.)
2.21 mm (0.0870 in.)
2.24 mm (0.0882 in.)
2.27 mm (0.0894 in.)
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.33 mm (0.0917 in.)
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AXLE
SS–55
AXLE
SERVICE DATA
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY
Front axle hub backlash
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Front axle hub deviation
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle shaft backlash
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle shaft deviation
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle shaft runout
Maximum:
1.5 mm (0.0591 in.)
Rear axle shaft flange runout
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
REAR AXLE SHAFT LH
SS
SS–56
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AXLE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front axle hub assembly x Lock nut
235
2,396
173
Steering knuckle x Tie rod end
91
928
67
Steering knuckle x Stabilizer link
70
714
52
Disc brake caliper x Steering knuckle
123
1,254
91
Disc brake caliper x Brake tube
15
155
11
Front brake tube bracket set bolt
26
296
21
ABS speed sensor wire harness bracket set bolt
13
133
10
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
SS
ABS speed sensor set bolt
8.3
85
73 in.*lbf
Steering knuckle x Upper ball joint
110
1,122
81
Steering knuckle x Lower ball joint
160
1,630
118
Steering knuckle x Front axle w/ ABS rotor bearing assembly
80
816
59
Front wheel adjusting nut x Front axle w/ ABS rotor bearing assembly
275
2,804
203
Front wheel
112
1,142
83
123
1,254
91
Rear axle shaft w/ backing plate x Disc brake caliper
47
480
35
ABS speed sensor set nut
8.3
85
73 in.*lbf
REAR AXLE SHAFT
Axle housing x Rear axle shaft
Rear brake tube x Master cylinder
15
155
11
Rear wheel
112
1,142
83
SS–56
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION CONTROL
SUSPENSION CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
Amount of change in vehicle height
HIGH position:
40 mm (1.57 in.)
LOW position:
-20 mm (-0.79 in.)
Difference between the right side and the left side
SS
measure vehicle height value:
Air suspension
using the intelligent tester value:
not Using the intelligent tester value:
Difference between the tester value and vehicle height
(D-C measurement):
10 mm (0.39 in.) or less
5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
0.2 V or less
5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
Height control sensor link
standard length:
Reas
6.5 to 15.0 mm (0.26 to 0.59 in.)
Joint gap space
dimension of gap:
1 mm (0.04 in.)
SS–57
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Height control sensor link x Upper control arm assembly
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Height control sensor link lock nut
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Height control compressor assembly x Height control dryer assembly
6.4
65
57 in.*lbf
Height control bracket x Frame
29
300
21
Height control compressor assembly x Height control bracket
5.9
60
52 in.*lbf
Height control filter x Height control bracket
6.4
65
57 in.*lbf
Rear disc wheel
112
1,140
83
Height control reservoir assembly x body
29
300
21
Suspension control ECU x body
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Height control sensor sub-assembly x body
13
133
10
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION
SS–57
SUSPENSION
SERVICE DATA
Vehicle height (2WD Except air suspension)
UZN210L-GKAGKA
Front A-B:
Rear C-D:
71.7 mm (2.82 in.)
UZN210L-GKAZKA
Front A-B:
113.5 mm (4.47 in.)
Rear C-D:
72.3 mm (2.85 in.)
GRN210L-GKPGKA
Front A-B:
110.5 mm (4.35 in.)
Rear C-D:
70.9 mm (2.79 in.)
Front A-B:
110.4 mm (4.35 in.)
Rear C-D:
71.3 mm (2.81 in.)
Front A-B:
112.7 mm (4.44 in.)
Rear C-D:
81.4 mm (3.20 in.)
UZN215L-GKAGKA
Front A-B:
99.9 mm (3.93 in.)
Rear C-D:
71.6 mm (2.82 in.)
UZN215L-GKAZKA
Front A-B:
99.8 mm (3.93 in.)
Rear C-D:
72.1 mm (2.84 in.)
GRN215L-GKPGKA
Front A-B:
99.8 mm (3.93 in.)
Rear C-D:
71.3 mm (2.81 in.)
GRN215L-GKPZKA
Front A-B:
99.8 mm (3.93 in.)
Rear C-D:
71.9 mm (2.83 in.)
Front A-B:
99.2 mm (3.91 in.)
Rear C-D:
78.9 mm (3.11 in.)
GRN210L-GKPZKA
113.6 mm (4.47 in.)
Vehicle height (2WD Air suspension)
UZN210L-GKAZKA
Vehicle height (4WD Except air suspension)
Vehicle height (4WD Air suspension)
UZN215L-GKAZKA
Front wheel
alignment
Toe-in (total)
0°05' +- 0°10' (0.08° +- 0.16°)
1 +- 2 mm (0.04 +- 0.08 in.)
Rack end length difference
1.0 mm (0.04 in.) or less
Inside wheel
37°00' (35°00' to 38°00')
Wheel angle (2WD)
37.00° (35.00° to 38.00°)
Outside wheel: Reference
32°30'
32.50°
Wheel angle (4WD)
Inside wheel
36°40' (34°40' to 37°40')
36.67° (34.67° to 37.67°)
Outside wheel: Reference
32°53'
32.88°
Camber
2WD Except air suspension
-0°28' +- 45' (-0.47° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
2WD Air suspension
45' (0.75°) or less
-0°30' +- 45' (-0.50° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
-0°09' +- 45' (-0.15° +- 0.75°)
4WD Except air suspension
Right-left error
4WD Air suspension
45' (0.75°) or less
-0°10' +- 45' (-0.17° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
SS
SS–58
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION
Caster
2WD Except air suspension
3°23' +- 45' (3.38° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
2WD Air suspension
3°33' +- 45' (3.55° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
4WD Except air suspension
3°13' +- 45' (3.22° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
4WD Air suspension
SS
Front wheel
alignment
3°22' +- 45' (3.37° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
Steering axis inclination
2WD Except air suspension
12°58' +- 45' (12.97° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
2WD Air suspension
13°00' +- 45' (13.00° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
4WD Except air suspension
12°39' +- 45' (12.65° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
4WD Air suspension
12°40' +- 45' (12.67° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error 45' (0.75°) or less
Upper arm ball joint turning torque
4.5 N*m (46 kgf*cm, 40 in.*lbf) or less
Front suspension
Lower arm ball joint turning torque
3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf) or less
Stabilizer link ball joint turning torque
2.0 N*m (20 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf) or less
Rear suspension
Stabilizer link ball joint turning torque
0.05 to 2.0 N*m (0.5 to 20 kgf*cm, 0.4 to 0.7 in.*lbf)
A: Ground clearance of front wheel center
B: Ground clearance of lower suspension arm No. 2 set bolt
center
C: Ground clearance of rear wheel center
D: Ground clearance of strut rod set bolt center
SS–60
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – TIRE AND WHEEL
TIRE AND WHEEL
SERVICE DATA
Cold tire inflation
pressure:
(Except MEXICO)
SS
Cold tire inflation
pressure:
(MEXICO)
Tire size:
P265/60R18 109H Front, Rear
P265/65R17 110S Front, Rear
220 kPa (2.2 kgf*cm2, 32 psi)
P265/70R16 111S Front, Rear
Tire size:
P265/65R17 112S Front, Rear
P265/70R16 111S Front, Rear
Tire runout
Imbalance after adjustment
200 kPa (2.0 kgf*cm2, 29 psi)
3.0 mm (0.118 in.) or less
265/70R16:
8 g (0.018 lb) or less
265/65R17:
7 g (0.015 lb) or less
SS–61
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – TIRE AND WHEEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Tire pressure monitor valve x Disc wheel
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Tire pressure monitor receiver set bolt
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
SS
SS–61
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE CONTROL
BRAKE CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front speed sensor x Steering knuckle
Part Tightened
8.3
85
73 in.*lbf
Rear speed sensor x Axle hub
8.3
85
73 in.*lbf
SS
SS–62
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE
BRAKE
SERVICE DATA
SS
Brake pedal height (from dash panel)
166.1 to 176.1 mm (6.539 to 6.933 in.)
Rod operating adapter length
232.5 to 242.5 mm (9.154 to 9.547 in.)
Brake pedal free play
Pedal free play: 1 to 6 mm (0.04 to 0.24 in.)
Stop light switch clearance
0.5 to 2.5 mm (0.020 to 0.098 in.)
Pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 490 N (50 kgf, 110.2 lbf)
More than 55 mm (2.17 in.)
Front pad lining thickness
Standard thickness: 11.5 mm (0.453 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Front disc thickness
Standard thickness: 28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness: 26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Front disc runout
Maximum disc runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear pad lining thickness
Standard thickness: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Rear disc thickness
Standard thickness: 18.0 mm (0.709 in.)
Minimum thickness: 16.0 mm (0.630 in.)
Rear disc runout
Maximum disc runout: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
SS–63
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
Bleeder plug
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
11
112
8
Brake pedal sub-assembly x Brake pedal support sub-assembly
34.3
350
25
Brake pedal support sub-assembly x Body
14.2
145
10
Brake pedal support sub-assembly x Brake pedal support
reinforcement
34.3
350
25
Front disc brake cylinder x Steering knuckle
123
1,254
91
Flexible hose x Disc brake cylinder assembly rear
31
316
23
Rear disc brake cylinder mounting x Axle hub
105
1,071
77
Rear disc brake cylinder mounting x Disc brake cylinder assembly
rear
88
897
65
Flexible hose x Disc brake cylinder assembly rear
31
316
23
Skid control ECU assembly set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Junction block assembly x Reinforcement
8.4
85
74 in.*lbf
Master cylinder solenoid set bolts
32
326
24
Brake master cylinder x Pin
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Rod Operating adapter lock nut
26
260
19
Master cylinder push rod clevis lock nut
26
260
19
Brake booster pump x Brake booster accumulator
57
585
42
Brake master cylinder x Brake booster pump bracket No. 2
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Master cylinder solenoid x Brake booster pump assembly wire
harness
2.9
30
26 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder assembly
Brake actuator tube No.1 union nuts
14 (15)
143 (155)
10 (11)
Brake line union nut
14 (15)
145 (158)
10 (11)
Brake master cylinder x Brake actuator bracket No. 1
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder x Brake actuator bracket No. 3
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder x Master cylinder reservoir
1.7
17
15 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder set nuts
14
145
10
( ): For use without SST
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – PARKING BRAKE
SS–63
PARKING BRAKE
SERVICE DATA
Parking brake lever travel at 196 N (20 kgf, 44.1 lbf):
5 to 7 clicks
Rear brake disc inside diameter (Standard)
210 mm (8.27 in.)
Rear brake disc inside diameter (Maximum)
211 mm (8.30 in.)
Parking brake shoe lining thickness (Standard)
4.0 mm (0.158 in.)
Parking brake shoe lining thickness (Maximum)
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
SS
SS–64
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – PARKING BRAKE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Wheel nut
112
1,137
83
Parking brake lock nut (Front side)
13
127
9
Parking brake lock nut (Rear side)
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Parking brake pedal x Body
13
127
9
Floor heat insulator x Body
13
127
9
Parking brake cable assembly No. 1 x Body (Bolt)
13
127
9
Parking brake cable assembly No. 1 x Body (Nut)
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Parking brake cable assembly No. 3 x Fram
13
127
9
Parking brake cable assembly No. 3 x Backing plate
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
SS–64
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
SERVICE DATA
Steering wheel free play
SS
Maximum
30 mm (1.18 in.)
SS–65
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STEERING COLUMN
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
Steering wheel set nut
50
510
37
Steering wheel pad set screw ("Torx" screw)
8.8
90
78 in.*lbf
Steering column assembly set nut
26
270
20
Main shaft assembly x Steering intermediate shaft
36
360
20
Steering sliding yoke x Intermediate shaft No. 2
36
360
27
Power steering gear box x Intermediate shaft No. 2
36
360
27
Steering sliding yoke x Intermediate shaft
36
360
27
Telescopic lever lock bolt x Telescopic lever
23
240
17
Steering column protector x Steering column
ft.*lbf
6
60
52 in.*lbf
Turn signal bracket x Steering column
5.7
58
50 in.*lbf
Tilt steering bolt
20
204
15
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – POWER STEERING
SS–65
POWER STEERING
SERVICE DATA
POWER STEERING FLUID
Fluid level rise
Maximum:
5 mm (0.20 in.)
Fluid pressure at idle speed with valve
closed
Minimum:
8,336 kPa (85 kgf/cm2, 1,209 psi)
STEERING WHEEL
Steering effort at idle speed
(Reference)
6 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
Vane pump rotating torque
Vane pump shaft and vane pump
housing oil clearance
0.28 N*m (2.8 kgf*cm, 2.4 in.*lbf) or less
STD:
Maximum:
0.03 to 0.05 mm (0.0012 to 0.0020 in.)
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Vane plate height
Minimum:
8.6 mm (0.33858 in.)
Vane plate thickness
Minimum:
1.397 mm (0.05500 in.)
Vane plate length
Minimum:
14.991 mm (0.59020 in.)
Clearance between the rotor groove and
plate
Maximum:
0.033 mm (0.00130 in.)
Spring free length
Minimum:
33.2 mm (1.307 in.)
POWER STEERING GEAR
Total preload (Tie rod rotating torque)
(Turning)
0.29 to 1.96 N*m (2.9 to 20.0 kgf*cm, 2.57 to 17.35 in.*lbf)
Total preload in center position (Control
valve rotating torque)
(Turning)
1.35 to 1.55 N*m (13.77 to 15.81 kgf*cm, 11.94 to 13.71 in.*lbf)
SS
SS–66
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – POWER STEERING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
24
240
17
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
Vane pump housing rear x Vane pump housing front
SS
Pressure port union
83
850
61
Suction port union set bolt
13
130
9
Vane pump assembly x Vane pump bracket rear
43
438
32
Vane pump assembly x Stud bolt
22
224
16
Vane pump pulley set nut
44
449
32
Pressure feed tube assembly x Vane pump assembly
51
520
38
Pressure feed tube assembly clamp set bolt
7.8
80
69 in.*lbf
POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
Control valve housing set bolt
18
184
13
Bering guide nut
25
250
18
Rack guide spring cap
25
250
18
Rack guide spring cap lock nut
69 (65)
700 (660)
51 (48)
Power steering rack x Rack end
103 (98)
1,050 (1,000)
76 (72)
88
897
65
25 (23)
250 (230)
18 (17)
100
1,020
74
44 (42)
449 (428)
32 (31)
28
286
21
Tie rod assembly lock nut
Turn pressure tube union nut
Power steering link assembly set bolt and nut
Pressure feed and return tubes x Control valve housing
Pressure feed tube clamp set bolt
Outlet return tube
44 (42)
449 (428)
32 (31)
Tie rod end x steering knuckle
91
928
67
Stabilizer bar front bracket set bolt
40
408
30
( ): For use without SST
SS–66
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
SERVICE DATA
SS
Refrigerant charge volume (Standard)
570 to 630 g (20.1 to 22.22 oz.)
Magnetic clutch clearance (2UZ-FE)
0.35 to 0.60 mm (0.013 to 0.023 in.)
Magnetic clutch clearance (1GR-FE)
0.35 to 0.60 mm (0.013 to 0.023 in.)
SS–67
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AIR CONDITIONING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Air conditioning tube assembly x Cooler evaporator sub-assembly No.
1
3.5
35
30 in.*lbf
Air conditioner unit assembly x Body
5.5
55
48 in.*lbf
Air conditioner unit assembly x Instrument panel reinforcement
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Wiring harness x Instrument panel reinforcement
83
85
73 in.*lbf
Steering column assembly x Instrument panel reinforcement
26
265
19
AIR CONDITIONER UNIT
BLOWER UNIT
Blower assembly x Body
5.5
55
48 in.*lbf
Blower assembly x Instrument panel reinforcement
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
18
183
13
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
Magnet clutch hub x Cooler compressor assembly
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Engine (Bolt)
46
469
34
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Engine (Nut)
24
245
18
Discharge hose sub-assembly x Compressor and magnetic clutch
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Suction hose sub-assembly x Compressor and magnetic clutch
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
18
183
13
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Engine
24
245
18
Discharge hose sub-assembly x Compressor and magnetic clutch
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Suction hose sub-assembly x Compressor and magnetic clutch
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
Magnet clutch hub x Cooler compressor assembly
CONDENSER
Cap x Cooler condenser core
2.9
29
25 in.*lbf
Cooler condenser core x Body
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Air conditioning tube assembly x Cooler condenser core
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Discharge hose sub-assembly x Cooler condenser core
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
SS
SS–67
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Steering pad x Steering wheel assembly
Part Tightened
8.8
90
78 in.*lbf
Steering wheel assembly x Steering column assembly
50
510
37
Front passenger airbag assembly x Instrument panel reinforcement
20
200
14
Curtain shield airbag assembly x Body
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Center airbag sensor assembly x Body
17.5
178
13
Front airbag sensor x Body (Length A)
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Front airbag sensor x Body (Length B)
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Side airbag sensor x Body
17.5
178
13
Rear airbag sensor x Body
17.5
178
13
Seat position airbag sensor x Front seat assembly LH
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
SS
SS–68
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
FRONT SEAT BELT
SS
Front seat outer belt assembly RH (Upper part of retractor) x Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Front seat outer belt assembly RH (Lower part of retractor) x Body
42
430
31
Front seat inner belt assembly x Front seat
42
430
31
Front shoulder belt anchor adjuster assembly x Body
42
430
31
Front seat outer belt floor anchor x Body
42
430
31
Front seat outer belt shoulder anchor x Body
42
430
31
42
430
31
REAR SEAT BELT (2nd seat type)
Rear seat belt assembly outer center x Body
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly inner x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat inner with center belt assembly x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Upper part of retractor) x
Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Lower part of retractor) x
Body
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Floor anchor side) x Body
42
430
31
REAR SEAT BELT (3rd seat type)
3 point type belt assembly LH x Rear seat assembly
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly inner x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat belt assembly inner x Body
42
430
31
Rear No. 1 seat belt assembly inner LH x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Upper part of retractor) x
Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Lower part of retractor) x
Body
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Floor anchor side) x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt assembly outer (Shoulder anchor side) x
Body
42
430
31
SS–69
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Wiper motor x Wiper link
Part Tightened
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Wiper link x Body
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Wiper arm x Wiper link
25
255
18.4
Rear wiper motor x Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Rear wiper motor x Rear wiper arm
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
SS
SS–70
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – HORN
HORN
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
20
199
15
20
199
15
HIGH PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
High pitched horn assembly x Body
LOW PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
SS
Low pitched horn assembly x Body
SS–71
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – OTHER SYSTEM
OTHER SYSTEM
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
Voltage inverter assembly x Body
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
SS
SS–72
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – MIRROR
MIRROR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
Outer rear view mirror assembly x Front door
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
SS–73
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
Instrument Panel Reinforcement x Passenger Airbag
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
20
204
15
SS
SS–74
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SEAT
SEAT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
Seat position airbag sensor x Seat adjuster assembly
Seatback cover bracket x Seat adjuster assembly
SS
5.5
56
48 in.*lbf
Front seat Inner belt assembly LH x Seat adjuster assembly
(w/ Side airbag)
42
428
31
Front seat assembly LH x Body
37
375
27
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
Seat position airbag sensor x Seat adjuster assembly
Seatback cover bracket x Seat adjuster assembly
5.5
56
48 in.*lbf
Front seat Inner belt assembly LH x Seat adjuster assembly
(w/ Side airbag)
42
428
31
Front seat assembly LH x Body
37
375
27
42
428
31
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
Seat belt assembly outer center x Body
Bolt
Nut
Seatback hinge x Seatback frame
42
428
31
37
377
27
Seatback hinge x Body
18
184
13
Seatlock striker x Body
18
184
13
Seatback hinge center x Body
18
184
13
Seatback hinge center x Seatback frame
37
377
27
Armrest assembly center x Seatback assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
No. 1 seat hinge assembly x Seat cushion frame
18
184
13
No. 1 seat hinge assembly x Body
37
377
27
REAR NO. 1 SEAT (3rd SEAT)
Rear No. 1 seat LH and RH x Body
37
375
27
Rear seat belt inner x Rear seat cushion frame
42
430
31
Rear seat belt inner No. 2 x Rear seat cushion frame
42
430
31
Rear seat 3-joint type belt assembly LH x Rear seat cushion frame
42
430
31
Rear seatback frame x Rear seat cushion frame
50
510
37
REAR NO. 2 SEAT (3rd SEAT)
Seat No. 1 cushion frame x Rear seat frame
18
185
13
Rear seat belt inner x Rear seat frame
42
430
31
SS–75
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Auxiliary catch hook x Hood
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Auxiliary catch release lever x Hood
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Hood x Hood hinge
13
130
10
Hood x Hood lock
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Hood bulge x Hood
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Hood support x Hood
17.5
180
13
Radiator grille x Hood
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door check x Body
30
306
22
Door check x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door frame sub-assembly rear lower x Door panel
5
51
42 in.*lbf
Door glass x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Door hinge x Body
26
265
19
Door hinge x Door panel
26
265
19
Door lock x Door panel
5.0
51
42 in.*lbf
Door lock striker x Body
23
235
17
Door outside handle cover x Door panel
4
41
35 in.*lbf
Door outside handle frame x Door panel
4
41
35 in.*lbf
Door wire x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Front NO. 2 speaker x Door Panel
5
51
42 in.*lbf
HOOD
FRONT DOOR
Outer view mirror x Door panel
Power window regulator motor x Window regulator
Window regulator x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
8
82
71 in.*lbf
REAR DOOR
Division bar x Door panel
5
51
44 in.*lbf
Door check x Body
30
306
22
Door check x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door glass x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Door hinge x Body
26
265
19
Door hinge x Door panel
26
265
19
Door lock x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door lock striker x Body
23
235
17
Door outside handle cover x Door panel
4
41
35 in.*lbf
Door outside handle frame x Door panel
4
41
35 in.*lbf
Outer view mirror x Door panel
Power window regulator motor x Window regulator
Window regulator x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
5.4
55
48 in. lbf
8
82
71 in.*lbf
BACK DOOR
Door glass x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Door hinge x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Door hinge x Body
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Door lock x Door panel
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Door lock cylinder x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door lock striker x Body
27
275
20
Dumper rubber x Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
SS
SS–76
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Power window regulator motor x Window regulator
Part Tightened
1.7
17
15 in.*lbf
Stopper lower x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
8
82
71 in.*lbf
Window regulator x Door panel
SS
SS–77
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – EXTERIOR
EXTERIOR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Front bumper reinforcement x Body
58
591
43
Front bumper cover x Radiator grille lower
7.5
77
66 in.*lbf
Bolt:
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Screw:
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
Front bumper side support x Body
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
Front bumper reinforcement plate x Body
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Nut:
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Bolt:
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
No. 2 rear bumper reinforcement x Body
25
255
18
Rear bumper side mounting bracket x Body
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Rear bumper bar reinforcement x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Rear bumper end retainer x Body
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
Rear bumper retainer upper x Body
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
Bolt:
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Screw:
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Rear spoiler x Back door
7.0
71
62 in. lbf
Rear spoiler x Center stop light
2.5
25
22 in.*lbf
10.0
102
7.4
Side step bracket x Body
19.5
199
14
Side step bracket x LH Step sub-assembly
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Rear quarter outside moulding sub-assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Front wheel opening extension sub-assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
FRONT BUMPER
Front bumper cover x Body
Front bumper side mounting bracket x Body
REAR BUMPER
Rear bumper cover x Body
REAR SPOILER
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING LH
Roof rack bracket front LH x Body
LH STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE MOULDING
Step sub-assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Rocker panel moulding sub-assembly x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Front door outside moulding sub-assembly
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
SS
SS–78
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – INTERIOR
INTERIOR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
ROOF HEADLINING
SS
Front seat outer belt x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat outer belt x Body
42
430
31
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SLIDING ROOF
SS–79
SLIDING ROOF
SERVICE DATA
Sliding roof
Difference in level between sliding roof weatherstrip and roof panel
Front end and rear end
0 +- 1.5 mm (0 +- 0.059 in.)
Corner of rear side
0 +- 2.0 mm (0 +- 0.079 in.)
Difference in level between sliding roof glass and roof panel front end and rear end
Front end and rear end
6.7 +- 0.7 mm (0.264 +- 0.028 in.)
SS
SS–80
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SLIDING ROOF
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Sliding roof glass assembly x Drive cable
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Sliding roof housing sub-assembly x Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Sliding roof housing sub-assembly x Sliding roof drive gear
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
MAINTENANCE – OUTSIDE VEHICLE
MA–1
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
Check the parts of the vehicle described below on a daily
basis. Performing maintenance checks on the vehicle is the
owner's responsibility. The owner may take the vehicle to a
service center but it is recommended that the owner perform
the checks.
In most cases, special tools are not required.
The procedures for general maintenance are as follows.
1.
GENERAL NOTES
• Maintenance requirements very depending on the
country.
• Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's
manual supplement.
• Following the maintenance schedule is mandatory.
• Determine the appropriate time to service the vehicle
using either miles driven or time (months) elapsed,
whichever reaches the specification first.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
TIRES
(a) Check the tire pressure with a gauge. Make
adjustments if necessary.
(b) Check the surfaces of tires for cuts, damage or
excessive wear.
3.
WHEEL NUTS
(a) Check for nuts that are loose or missing. Tighten
them if necessary.
4.
TIRE ROTATION
Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's manual
supplement.
5.
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
(a) Check the blades for wear or cracks when they are
unable to wipe the windshield clean. Replace them
if necessary.
6.
FLUID LEAKS
(a) Check under the vehicle for leaking fuel, oil, water
and other fluids.
NOTICE:
If you smell gasoline fumes or notice any leaks,
locate the cause and correct it.
7.
DOORS AND ENGINE HOOD
(a) Check that all of the doors operate smoothly, and
that all the latches lock securely.
(b) When the primary latch is released, check that the
engine hood secondary latch prevents the hood
from opening.
MA
MA–2
MAINTENANCE – INSIDE VEHICLE
INSIDE VEHICLE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
Check the parts of the vehicle described below on a daily
basis. Performing maintenance checks on the vehicle is the
owner's responsibility. The owner may take the vehicle to a
service center but it is recommended that the owner perform
the checks.
In most cases, special tools are not required.
The procedures for general maintenance are as follows.
MA
1.
GENERAL NOTES
• Maintenance requirements very depending on the
country.
• Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's
manual supplement.
• Determine the appropriate time to service the vehicle
using either miles driven or time (months) elapsed,
whichever reaches the specification first.
• Maintain similar intervals between periodic
maintenance unless noted.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn
signal lights, and other lights illuminate or blink.
Also, check that they have enough brightness.
3.
WARNING LIGHTS AND BUZZERS
(a) Check that all the warning lights and buzzers are
working.
4.
HORNS
(a) Check that the horn is working.
5.
WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Check for scratches, pits or abrasions.
6.
WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
(a) Check that the washers are aimed properly. Also,
check that the washer fluid hits the center of the
operating range of each wiper on the windshield.
(b) Check that the wipers streak or not. Replace the
wiper if necessary.
7.
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER
(a) When the heater or air conditioner is on the
defroster setting, check that air comes out of the
defroster outlet.
8.
REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) Check that the rear view mirror is securely mounted.
9.
SUN VISORS
(a) Check that the sun visors move freely and are
securely mounted.
MAINTENANCE – INSIDE VEHICLE
MA–3
10. STEERING WHEEL
(a) Check that the steering wheel has the proper free
play. Also check for steering difficulty, unusual
noises (See page SR-2).
11. SEATS
(a) Check that the seat adjusters, seatback recliner and
other front seat controls operate smoothly.
(b) Check that all the latches lock securely in all
positions.
(c) Check that the locks hold securely in all positions.
(d) Check that the headrests move up and down
smoothly and that the locks hold securely in all
latched positions.
(e) When the rear seatbacks are folded down, check
that the latches lock securely.
12. SEAT BELTS
(a) Check that the seat belt system such as the
buckles, retractors and anchors operate properly
and smoothly.
(b) Check that the belt webbing is not cut, frayed, worn
or damaged.
13. ACCELERATOR PEDAL
(a) Check that the pedal operates smoothly. In other
words, check that the pedal does not have uneven
pedal resistance or become stuck in certain
positions.
14. BRAKE PEDAL
(a) Check that the pedal operates smoothly.
(b) Check that the pedal has the proper reserve
distance and free play (See page BR-8).
(c) Start the engine and check the brake booster
function.
15. BRAKES
(a) In a safe place, check that the vehicle remains
straight when applying the brakes.
16. PARKING BRAKE
(a) Check that the pedal or lever has the proper range
of motion (See page PB-1).
(b) On a low incline, check that the parking brake alone
can stabilize the vehicle.
17. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION "PARK" MECHANISM
(a) Check the lock release button of the shift lever for
proper and smooth operation.
(b) When the shift lever is in the P position and all
brakes are released on a low incline, check that the
vehicle is stable.
MA
MA–4
MAINTENANCE – UNDER HOOD
UNDER HOOD
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
GENERAL NOTES
• Maintenance requirements very depending on the
country.
• Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's
manual supplement.
• Following the maintenance schedule is mandatory.
• Determine the appropriate time to service the vehicle
using either miles driven or time elapsed, whichever
reaches the specification first.
• Maintain similar intervals between periodic
maintenance unless noted.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
(a) Check that there is sufficient fluid in the tank.
3.
ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
(a) Check that the coolant level is between the "FULL"
and "LOW" lines on the see-through reservoir.
4.
RADIATOR AND HOSES
(a) Check that the front of the radiator is clean and free
of leaves, dirt and bugs.
(b) Check the hoses for cracks, kinks, rotting or loose
connections.
5.
BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
(a) Check that the electrolyte level of all the battery
cells is between the upper and lower lines on the
case.
HINT:
If the electrolyte level is difficult to see, lightly shake
the vehicle.
6.
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
(a) Check that the brake fluid levels are near the upper
level line on the see-through reservoirs.
7.
ENGINE DRIVE BELT
(a) Check the drive belt for fraying, cracks, wear or
oiliness.
8.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
(a) Check the level on the dipstick with the engine
turned off.
9.
POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL
(a) Check the level on the dipstick.
(b) The level should be in the "HOT" or "COLD" range
depending on the fluid temperature.
MA
10. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
(a) Visually check the overflow plug and oil pan for fluid
leaks or traces of fluid.
MAINTENANCE – UNDER HOOD
MA–5
11. EXHAUST SYSTEM
(a) Check for unusual exhaust sounds or abnormal
exhaust fumes. Locate the cause and correct it.
MA
MA–6
MAINTENANCE – ENGINE
ENGINE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
HINT:
Inspect these items on a cooled down engine.
1.
Type
See procedures
2UZ-FE
See page EM-19
2.
MA
REPLACE TIMING BELT
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page EM-6
2UZ-FE
See page EM-6
3.
REPLACE SPARK PLUGS
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page IG-3
2UZ-FE
See page IG-1
4.
REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page LU-1
2UZ-FE
See page LU-1
5.
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page CO-1
2UZ-FE
See page CO-1
6.
INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS
(a) Visually check the pipes, hangers and connections
for severe corrosion, leaks or damage.
7.
INSPECT BATTERY
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page CH-3
2UZ-FE
See page CH-3
8.
INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER
(a) Remove the air filter.
(b) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
damaged or oily. If necessary, replace the air filter.
(c) Reinstall the air filter.
9.
REPLACE AIR CLEANER FILTER
(a) Replace the air filter with a new one.
10. INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP GASKET
A054323
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page EC-2
2UZ-FE
See page EC-5
MA–7
MAINTENANCE – ENGINE
11. INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS AND
FUEL TANK VAPOR VENT SYSTEM HOSES AND
FUEL TANK BANDS
(a) Visually check the fuel lines for cracks, leakage,
loose connections, deformation or tank band
looseness.
12. INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page EC-2
2UZ-FE
See page EC-5
13. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
Type
See procedures
1GR-FE
See page EM-8
2UZ-FE
See page EM-7
MA
MA–8
MAINTENANCE – BRAKE
BRAKE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
INSPECT BRAKE LINE PIPES AND HOSES
HINT:
Work in a well-lighted area. Turn the front wheels fully to
the right or left before beginning the inspection.
(a) Using a mirror, check the entire circumference and
length of the brake lines and hoses for:
• Damage
• Wear
• Deformation
• Cracks
• Corrosion
• Leaks
• Bends
• Twists
(b) Check all the clamps for tightness and the
connections for leakage.
(c) Check that the hoses and lines are not near sharp
edges, moving parts or the exhaust system.
(d) Check that the lines are installed properly and pass
through the center of the grommets.
2.
INSPECT BRAKE PEDAL
(See page BR-8)
3.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE
(See page PB-1)
4.
INSPECT BRAKE LININGS AND DRUMS
(a) Check the brake linings and drums. Also check the
brake linings of parking brake.
HINT:
• If a squealing or scraping noise is heard from the
brake while driving, check the pad wear indicator.
• If there are traces of the indicator contacting the
disc rotor, the disc pad should be replaced.
5.
INSPECT FRONT BRAKE
(a) Check the front brake pads and discs (See page
BR-40).
6.
INSPECT REAR BRAKE
(a) Check the rear brake pads, discs linings and drums
(See page BR-46).
7.
INSPECT OR CHANGE BRAKE FLUID
(See page BR-3)
Fluid:
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
P009958E01
MA
S002432
MA–9
MAINTENANCE – CHASSIS
CHASSIS
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
INSPECT STEERING LINKAGE & GEAR HOUSING
(a) Check the steering wheel free play (See page SR2).
(b) Check the steering linkage for looseness or
damage.
(1) Check that the tie rod ends do not have
excessive play.
(2) Check that the dust seals and boots are not
damaged.
(3) Check that the boot clamps are not loose.
(4) Check that the steering gear housing is not
damaged.
(5) Check that the connector are properly
connected to the steering gear housing.
2.
INSPECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING OIL
(a) Check the steering gear housing oil leakage.
If leakage is found, check and repair the cause.
3.
INSPECT BALL JOINT AND DUST COVER
(a) Inspect the ball joints for excessive looseness.
(1) Jack up the front of the vehicle and place
wooden blocks with a height of 180 to 200 mm
(7.09 to 7.87 in.) under the front tires.
(2) Lower the vehicle until the front coil spring has
about half its ordinary load. Place stands under
the vehicle for safety.
(3) Check that the front wheels are pointing
straight ahead. Use wheel chocks on all 4
wheels.
(4) Using a lever, pry up the end of the lower arm.
Check the amount of play.
Maximum ball joint vertical play:
0 mm (0 in.)
If there is any play, replace the ball joint.
(b) Check the dust cover for damage.
4.
INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT BOOTS
(a) Check the drive shaft boots for loose clamps,
grease leakage, kinks or damage.
5.
CHECK AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
(a) Visually check the transmission for fluid leakage. If
oil is leaking, find the cause and repair it.
Type
See procedures
A750F
See page AT-316
A750E
See page AT-304
MA
MA–10
MAINTENANCE – CHASSIS
6.
MA
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL (for 4WD)
(a) Visually check the transfer for oil leakage. If oil is
leaking, find the cause and repair it.
Type
See procedures
VF4AM
See page TF-3
VF4BM
See page TF-3
7.
INSPECT FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (for
4WD)
(See page DF-3)
8.
INSPECT REAR DIFFERENTIAL OIL
(See page DF-3)
9.
INSPECT FRONT AND REAR SUSPENSION
Type
See procedures
Front Suspension
See page SP-12
Rear Suspension
See page SP-38
10. LUBRICATE PROPELLER SHAFT AND TIGHTEN
BOLTS
(a) 4WD:
Lubricate propeller shaft, referring to the lubrication
chart. Before pumping in grease, wipe off any mud
and dust on the grease fitting.
A: Propeller Shaft Spider
B: Propeller Shaft Sliding Yoke
B
A
C
C: Double-Cardan Joint
C
C
B065528E03
Grease grade
Spider
Lithium base chassis grease NLGI
No. 2
Slide yoke and double-cardan joint
Molybdenum disulphide lithium base
chassis grease NLGI No. 2
(b) Tighten the bolts for propeller shaft.
Type
See procedures
2WD
See page PR-6
4WD
See page PR-12
11. ROTATE TIRES
(See page TW-2)
MAINTENANCE – BODY
MA–11
BODY
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
TIGHTEN BOLTS AND NUTS ON CHASSIS AND
BODY
(a) Where necessary, tighten all the parts of the
chassis.
• Front axle and suspension
• Drive train
• Rear axle and suspension
• Brake system
• Engine mounting, etc.
(b) Where necessary, tighten all the parts of the body.
• Seat belt system
• Seat
• Doors and hood
• Body mountings
• Fuel tank
• Exhaust pipe system, etc.
2.
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING FILTER
(a) Remove the glove compartment assembly.
(b) Remove the filter case from the filter outlet.
(c) Remove the filter from the filter case.
(d) Replace the filter with a new one.
(e) Installation is in the reverse order.
3.
ROAD TEST
(a) Check the engine and chassis for abnormal noises.
(b) Check that the vehicle does not wander or pull to
one side.
(c) Check that the brakes work properly and do not
drag.
(d) Do setting of the parking brake shoes.
4.
BODY INSPECTION
(a) Check the body exterior for dents, scratches and
rust.
(b) Check the underbody for rust and damage.
If necessary, replace or repair.
5.
FINAL INSPECTION
(a) Check the operation of the body parts.
(1) Hood
• Auxiliary catch operates properly.
• Hood locks securely when closed.
(2) Front and rear doors
• Door locks operate properly.
• Doors close properly.
(3) Back door
• Door lock operates properly.
(4) Seats
• Seat adjusts easily and locks securely in any
position.
• Front seatback locks securely in any
position.
MA
MA–12
MAINTENANCE – BODY
• Folding-down rear seatbacks lock securely.
(5) Be sure to deliver a clean car. Especially check.
• Steering wheel
• Shift lever knob
• All switch knobs
• Door handles
• Seats
MA
ES–3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- A/F SENSOR HEATER RELAY
- EFI RELAY
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
- FUEL PUMP RELAY
- EFI FUSE
- ETCS FUSE
- STARTER RELAY
DLC3
- STARTER NO. 2 FUSE
CHARCOAL
CANISTER
ASSEMBLY
- CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
AIR FUEL RATIO
SENSOR (BANK 1)
ECM
MASS AIR FLOW
METER
VAPOR PRESSURE
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
THROTTLE BODY
(THROTTLE W/ MOTOR
BODY ASSEMBLY)
FUEL SUCTION W/PUMP AND
GAUGE TUBE ASSEMBLY
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
(ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR)
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR (BANK 1)
VSV FOR EVAP
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (BANK 2)
VSV FOR ACIS
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (BANK 2)
A119838E06
ES
ES–4
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
ES
FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
KNOCK SENSOR (BANK 1)
VVT SENSOR (BANK 1)
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(BANK 1)
VVT SENSOR (BANK 2)
KNOCK SENSOR (BANK 2)
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY (BANK 2)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
A119839E07
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–5
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
The intelligent tester can be used in steps 2, 3, 4, 6 and 9.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CONNECT INTELLIGENT TESTER TO DLC3
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tester,
inspect the DLC3.
NEXT
3
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA
(a) Check the DTC(s) and freeze frame data (See page ES31).
HINT:
Record or print DTCs and freeze frame data, if
necessary.
NEXT
4
CLEAR DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA
(a) Clear the DTC(s) and freeze frame data (See page ES31).
NEXT
5
CONDUCT VISUAL INSPECTION
NEXT
6
SET CHECK MODE DIAGNOSIS
(a) Set the check mode (See page ES-35).
NEXT
7
CONFIRM PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
HINT:
If the engine does not start, perform steps 9 and 11 first.
ES
ES–6
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
B
Result
Proceed to
Malfunction does not occur
A
Malfunction occurs
B
GO TO STEP 9
A
8
ES
SIMULATE SYMPTOMS
NEXT
9
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTC (See page ES-31).
Result
B
Result
Proceed to
Trouble code
A
No code
B
GO TO STEP 11
A
10
REFER TO DTC CHART
HINT:
Refer to the DTC chart (See page ES-50).
NEXT
GO TO STEP 13
11
CONDUCT BASIC INSPECTION
HINT:
Refer to "BASIC INSPECTION" (See page ES-7).
Result
B
A
Result
Proceed to
Malfunctioning parts not confirmed
A
Malfunctioning parts confirmed
B
GO TO STEP 16
ES–7
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
12
REFER TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Refer to "PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE" (See page ES21).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Malfunctioning circuit confirmed
A
Malfunctioning parts confirmed
B
B
GO TO STEP 16
ES
A
13
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
HINT:
Refer to "ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT" (See page ES372).
NEXT
14
CONDUCT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Result
Result
Proceed to
Malfunction not confirmed
A
Malfunction confirmed
B
B
GO TO STEP 17
A
15
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HINT:
Refer to "CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS" (See
page ES-7).
NEXT
GO TO STEP 17
16
NEXT
CONDUCT PARTS INSPECTION
ES–8
17
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
IDENTIFY PROBLEM
NEXT
18
ADJUST AND/OR REPAIR
NEXT
ES
19
NEXT
END
CONDUCT CONFIRMATION TEST
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–9
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
1.
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HINT:
For use of the intelligent tester only:
Inspect the vehicle's ECM using check mode.
Intermittent problems are easier to detect with an
intelligent tester when the ECM is in check mode. In
check mode, the ECM uses 1 trip detection logic, which
is more sensitive to malfunctions than normal mode
(default), which uses 2 trip detection logic.
(a) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
(b) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode
using an intelligent tester (See page ES-35).
(c) Perform a simulation test (See page IN-30).
(d) Check and wiggle the harness(es), connector(s)
and terminal(s) (See page IN-38).
ES
ES–10
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
BASIC INSPECTION
When a malfunction is not confirmed by the DTC check,
troubleshooting should be carried out in all circuits
considered to be possible causes of the problem. In many
cases, by carrying out the basic engine check shown in the
following flowchart, the location of the problem can be found
quickly and efficiently. Therefore, using this check is essential
when engine troubleshooting.
1
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
NOTICE:
Carry out this check with the engine stopped and ignition
switch OFF.
Result
ES
NG
Result
Proceed to
11 V or more
OK
Below 11 V
NG
CHARGE OR REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE CRANKS
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
OK
3
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE STARTS
NG
GO TO STEP 6
OK
4
CHECK AIR FILTER
(a) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
contaminated with dirt or oil.
NG
REPLACE AIR FILTER
OK
5
CHECK IDLING SPEED
(a) Check the idling speed (See page EM-2).
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–11
TROUBLESHOOT IDLING SPEED AND
PROCEED TO NEXT STEP
OK
6
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-4).
NG
TROUBLESHOOT FUEL PRESSURE AND
PROCEED TO NEXT STEP
OK
7
ES
CHECK FOR SPARK
(a) Check for spark (See page IG-1).
NG
OK
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
TROUBLESHOOT SPARK AND PROCEED
TO NEXT STEP
ES–56
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
The parameters listed in the chart are for reference only.
Factors such as instrument type may cause readings to differ
slightly from stated values.
If any DTCs are displayed during a check mode DTC check,
check the circuit for the DTCs listed in the table below. For
details of each DTC, refer to the "See page" below.
SFI SYSTEM:
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Areas
MIL
Memory
See page
P0010
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator
Circuit (Bank 1)
1. Open or short in Oil Control Valve (OCV)
circuit
2. OCV (bank 1)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-59
P0011
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing
Over-Advanced or System
Performance (Bank 1)
1. Valve timing
2. OCV
3. OCV filter
4. Camshaft timing gear assembly
5. ECM
Come on
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-64
P0012
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing
Over-Retarded (Bank 1)
Same as DTC P0011
Come on
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-64
P0016
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft
Position Correlation (Bank 1
Sensor A)
1. Mechanical system (Timing chain has jumped
tooth or chain
stretched)
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-70
P0018
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft
Position Correlation (Bank 2
Sensor A)
Same as DTC P0016
Come on
DTC stored
ES-70
P0020
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator
Circuit (Bank 2)
1. Open or short in OCV circuit
2. OCV (bank 2)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-59
P0021
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing
Over-Advanced or System
Performance (Bank 2)
Same as DTC P0011
Come on
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-64
P0022
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing
Over-Retarded (Bank 2)
Same as DTC P0011
Come on
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-64
P0031
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
1. Open in Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater
circuit
2. A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-73
P0032
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
1. Short in A/F sensor heater circuit
2. A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-73
P0037
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit Low (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Open in Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater
circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-78
P0038
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit High (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-78
P0051
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit Low (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
1. Open in A/F sensor heater circuit
2. A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-73
ES
ES–57
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Memory
See page
P0052
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit High (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Detection Item
1. Short in A/F sensor heater circuit
2. A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater relay
4. ECM
Trouble Areas
Come on
MIL
DTC stored
ES-73
P0057
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit Low (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Open in HO2 sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-78
P0058
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit High (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-78
P0100
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
1. Open or short in Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
circuit
2. MAF meter
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-85
ES
P0101
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
Range / Performance Problem
1. MAF meter
2 Air induction system
3 PCV hose connections
Come on
DTC stored
ES-92
P0102
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
Low Input
1. Open in MAF meter circuit
2. Short in ground circuit
3. MAF meter
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-85
P0103
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
High Input
1. Short in MAF meter circuit (+B circuit)
2. MAF meter
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-85
P0110
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
1. Open or short in Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
sensor circuit
2. IAT sensor (built into Mass Air Flow [MAF]
meter)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-95
P0111
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Gradient Too High
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
Come on
DTC stored
ES-101
P0112
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
Low Input
1. Short in IAT sensor circuit
2. IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-95
P0113
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
High Input
1. Open in IAT sensor circuit
2. IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-95
P0115
Engine Coolant Temperature
Circuit
1. Open or short in Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) sensor circuit
2. ECT sensor
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-104
P0116
Engine Coolant Temperature
Circuit Range / Performance
Problem
1. Thermostat
2. ECT sensor
Come on
DTC stored
ES-109
P0117
Engine Coolant Temperature
Circuit Low Input
1. Short in ECT sensor circuit
2. ECT sensor
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-104
P0118
Engine Coolant Temperature
Circuit High Input
1. Open in ECT sensor circuit
2. ECT sensor
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-104
P0120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
1. Throttle Position (TP) sensor (built into throttle
body)
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
P0121
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit Range /
Performance Problem
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
Come on
DTC stored
ES-120
P0122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit Low Input
1. TP sensor (built into throttle body)
2. Short in VTA1 circuit
3. Open in VC circuit
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
ES–58
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Memory
See page
P0123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit High Input
1. TP sensor (built into throttle body)
2. Open in VTA1 circuit
3. Open in E2 circuit
4. Short between VC and VTA1 circuits
5. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temperature
for Closed Loop Fuel Control
1. Cooling system
2. ECT sensor
3. Thermostat (water inlet)
Come on
DTC stored
ES-122
P0128
Coolant Thermostat (Coolant
Temperature Below Thermostat
Regulating Temperature)
1. Thermostat (water inlet)
2. Cooling system
3. ECT sensor
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-125
P0136
Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in HO2 sensor circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
4. A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
5. EFI relay
6. Gas leakage from exhaust system
Come on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0137
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low
Voltage (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Open in HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
4. EFI relay
5. Gas leakage from exhaust system
Come on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0138
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High
Voltage (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Short in HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
3. ECM internal circuit malfunction
Come on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0141
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-78
P0156
Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in HO2 sensor circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
4. A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
5. EFI relay
6. Gas leakage from exhaust system
Come on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0157
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low
Voltage (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Open in HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
4. EFI relay
5. Gas leakage from exhaust system
Come on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0158
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High
Voltage (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Short in HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
3. ECM internal circuit malfunction
Come on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0161
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-78
P0171
System Too Lean (Bank 1)
1. Air induction system
2. Injector blockage
3. MAF meter
4. ECT sensor
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in exhaust system
7. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
circuit
8. A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
9. A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
10. A/F sensor heater relay
11. A/F sensor heater and A/F sensor heater
relay circuits
12. PCV hose connections
13. PCV valve and hose
14. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-148
ES
Trouble Areas
MIL
ES–59
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Memory
See page
P0172
System Too Rich (Bank 1)
Detection Item
1. Injector leakage or blockage
2. MAF meter
3. ECT sensor
4. Ignition system
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in exhaust system
7. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
circuit
8. A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
9. A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
10. A/F sensor heater relay
11. A/F sensor heater and A/F sensor heater
relay circuits
12. ECM
Trouble Areas
Come on
MIL
DTC stored
ES-148
P0174
System Too Lean (Bank 2)
1. Air induction system
2. Injector blockage
3. MAF meter
4. ECT sensor
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in exhaust system
7. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
circuit
8. A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
9. A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
10. A/F sensor heater relay
11. A/F sensor heater and A/F sensor heater
relay circuits
12. PCV hose connections
13. PCV valve and hose
14. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-148
P0175
System Too Rich (Bank 2)
1. Injector leakage or blockage
2. MAF meter
3. ECT sensor
4. Ignition system
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in exhaust system
7. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
circuit
8. A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
9. A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
10. A/F sensor heater relay
11. A/F sensor heater and A/F sensor heater
relay circuits
12. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-148
P0220
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
1. TP sensor (built into throttle body)
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
P0222
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit Low Input
1. TP sensor (built into throttle body)
2. Short in VTA2 circuit
3. Open in VC circuit
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
P0223
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit High Input
1. TP sensor (built into throttle body)
2. Open in VTA2 circuit
3. Open in E2 circuit
4. Short between VC and VTA2 circuits
5. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
P0230
Fuel Pump Primary Circuit
1. Open or short in fuel pump relay circuit
2. Fuel pump relay
3. ECM
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-160
ES
ES–60
DTC Code
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
See page
P0300
Random / Multiple Cylinder
Misfire Detected
Detection Item
1. Open or short in engine wire harness
2. Connector connection
3. Vacuum hose connection
4. Ignition system
5. Injector
6. Fuel pressure
7. MAF meter
8. ECT sensor
9. Compression pressure
10. Valve clearance
11. Valve timing
12. PCV hose connection
13. PCV hose
14. ECM
15. Air induction system
Trouble Areas
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC P0300
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC P0300
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC P0300
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC P0300
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0305
Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC P0300
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0306
Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC P0300
Come on or
flash
DTC stored
ES-165
P0327
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low Input
(Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
1. Short in knock sensor 1 circuit
2. Knock sensor 1
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-178
P0328
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High Input
(Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
1. Open in knock sensor 1 circuit
2. Knock sensor 1
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-178
P0332
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit Low Input
(Bank 2)
1. Short in knock sensor 2 circuit
2. Knock sensor 2
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-178
P0333
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit High Input
(Bank 2)
1. Open in knock sensor 2 circuit
2. Knock sensor 2
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-178
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit
1. Open or short in Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) circuit
2. CKP sensor
3. Sensor plate (CKP sensor plate)
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-185
P0339
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit Intermittent
Same as DTC P0335
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-185
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
1. Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
2. VVT sensor
3. Camshaft timing pulley
4. Jumped tooth of timing chain
5. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-190
P0342
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit Low Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
Sam as DTC P0340
Come on
DTC stored
ES-190
P0343
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit High Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
Sam as DTC P0340
Come on
DTC stored
ES-190
P0345
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit (Bank 2)
Sam as DTC P0340
Come on
DTC stored
ES-190
P0347
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit Low Input (Bank 2)
Sam as DTC P0340
Come on
DTC stored
ES-190
ES–61
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Memory
See page
P0348
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit High Input (Bank 2)
Detection Item
Sam as DTC P0340
Trouble Areas
Come on
MIL
DTC stored
ES-190
P0351
Ignition Coil "A" Primary /
Secondary Circuit
1. Ignition system
2. Open or short in IGF1 or IGT circuit (1 to 6)
between ignition coil with igniter and ECM
3. No.1 to No.6 ignition coil with igniters
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-196
P0352
Ignition Coil "B" Primary /
Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC P0351
Come on
DTC stored
ES-196
P0353
Ignition Coil "C" Primary /
Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC P0351
Come on
DTC stored
ES-196
P0354
Ignition Coil "D" Primary /
Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC P0351
Come on
DTC stored
ES-196
P0355
Ignition Coil "E" Primary /
Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC P0351
Come on
DTC stored
ES-196
P0356
Ignition Coil "F" Primary /
Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC P0351
Come on
DTC stored
ES-196
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below
Threshold (Bank 1)
1. Gas leakage from exhaust system
2. A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
3. HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
4. Exhaust manifold (Three-Way Catalytic
Converter [TWC])
Come on
DTC stored
ES-205
P0430
Catalyst System Efficiency Below
Threshold (Bank 2)
1. Gas leakage from exhaust system
2. A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
3. HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
4. Exhaust manifold (Three-Way Catalytic
Converter [TWC])
Come on
DTC stored
ES-205
P043E
Evaporative Emission System
Reference Orifice Clog Up
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
4. Leakage from EVAP system
Come on
DTC stored
ES-212
P043F
Evaporative Emission System
Reference Orifice High Flow
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
4. Leakage from EVAP system
Come on
DTC stored
ES-212
P0441
Evaporative Emission Control
System Incorrect Purge Flow
1. Purge VSV
2. Connector/wire harness (Purge VSV-ECM)
3. ECM
4. Pump module
5. Leakage from EVAP system
6. Leakage from EVAP line (Purge VSV-Intake
manifold)
Come on
DTC stored
ES-218
P0450
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor / Switch
1. Pump module (including pressure sensor)
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-224
P0451
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor Range /
Performance
1. Pump module (including pressure sensor)
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-224
P0452
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor / Switch
Low Input
1. Pump module (including pressure sensor)
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-224
P0453
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor / Switch
High Input
1. Pump module (include pressure sensor)
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-224
ES
ES–62
DTC Code
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Memory
See page
P0455
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak Detected (Gross
Leak)
Detection Item
1. Fuel tank cap (loose)
2. Leakage from EVAP line (between canister
and fuel tank)
3. Leakage from EVAP line (between purge VSV
and canister)
4. Leakage from pump module
5. Leakage from fuel tank
6. Leakage from canister
Trouble Areas
Come on
MIL
DTC stored
ES-232
P0456
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak Detected (Very
Small Leak)
Same as DTC P0455
Come on
DTC stored
ES-232
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
1. Open or short in speed sensor circuit
2. Combination meter
3. ECM
4. Skid control ECU
Come on
DTC stored
ES-236
P0504
Brake Switch "A" / "B" Correlation
1. Short in stop light switch signal circuit
2. STOP fuse
3. Stop light switch
4. ECM
Does not
come on
DTC stored
ES-239
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
1. ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
2. Air induction system
3. PCV hose connection
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-244
P050A
Cold Start Idle Air Control System
Performance
1. Throttle body assembly
2. MAF meter
3. Air induction system
4. PCV hose connections
5. VVT system
6. Air cleaner filter element
7. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-248
P050B
Cold Start Ignition Timing
Performance
Same as DTC P050A
Come on
DTC stored
ES-248
P0560
System Voltage
1. Open in back up power source circuit
2. EFI fuse
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-254
P0604
Internal Control Module Random
Access Memory (RAM) Error
ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-258
P0606
ECM / PCM Processor
1. ECM
2. Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor (bank
1, 2 sensor 2)
Come on
DTC stored
ES-259
P0607
Control Module Performance
ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-262
P0617
Starter Relay Circuit High
1. Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch
2. Starter relay circuit
3. Ignition switch
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-264
P0630
VIN not Programmed or
Mismatch - ECM / PCM
ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-269
P0657
Actuator Supply Voltage Circuit /
Open
ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-271
P2102
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Circuit Low
1. Open in throttle actuator circuit
2. Throttle actuator
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-272
P2103
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Circuit High
1. Short in throttle actuator circuit
2. Throttle actuator
3. Throttle valve
4. Throttle body
5. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-272
P2111
Throttle Actuator Control System
- Stuck Open
1. Throttle actuator
2. Throttle body
3. Throttle valve
Come on
DTC stored
ES-276
ES–63
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Memory
See page
P2112
Throttle Actuator Control System
- Stuck Closed
Same as DTC P2111
Trouble Areas
Come on
MIL
DTC stored
ES-276
P2118
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Current Range / Performance
1. Open in ETCS power source circuit
2. ETCS fuse
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-279
P2119
Throttle Actuator Control Throttle
Body Range / Performance
1. ETCS
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-283
P2120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit
1. Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2121
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit Range /
Performance
1. APP sensor
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-294
P2122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit Low Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in VCP1 circuit
3. Open or ground short VPA circuit
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit High Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in EPA circuit
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2125
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit
1. APP sensor
2. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2127
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit Low Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in VCP2 circuit
3. Open or ground short VPA2 circuit
4. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2128
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit High Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in EPA2 circuit
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2135
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "A" / "B" Voltage
Correlation
1. Short between VTA1 and VTA2 circuits
2. TP sensor (built into throttle body)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-112
P2138
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" / "E" Voltage
Correlation
1. Short between VPA and VPA2 circuits
2. APP sensor
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-286
P2195
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Lean (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
4. A/F sensor heater relay
5. A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
6. Air induction system
7. Fuel pressure
8. Injector
9. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-298
P2196
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Rich (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2195
Come on
DTC stored
ES-298
P2197
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Lean (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
4. A/F sensor heater relay
5. A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
6. Air induction system
7. Fuel pressure
8. Injector
9. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-298
P2198
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Rich (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2197
Come on
DTC stored
ES-298
ES
ES–64
DTC Code
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Memory
See page
P2238
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping
Current Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Detection Item
1. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
4. A/F sensor heater relay
5. A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
6. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2239
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping
Current Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2238
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2241
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping
Current Circuit Low (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor
1) circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
4. A/F sensor heater relay
5. A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
6. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2242
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping
Current Circuit High (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2241
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2252
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2238
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2253
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2238
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2255
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit Low (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2241
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2256
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit High (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Same as DTC P2241
Come on
DTC stored
ES-313
P2401
Evaporative Emission System
Leak Detection Pump Control
Circuit Low
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
4. Leakage from EVAP
Come on
DTC stored
ES-320
P2402
Evaporative Emission System
Leak Detection Pump Control
Circuit High
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-320
P2419
Evaporative Emission System
Switching Valve Control Circuit
Low
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-326
P2420
Evaporative Emission System
Switching Valve Control Circuit
High
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire harness (between pump
module and ECM)
3. ECM
4. Leakage from EVAP
Come on
DTC stored
ES-326
P2610
ECM / PCM Internal Engine Off
Timer Performance
ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-332
P2A00
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow
Response (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
2. A/F sensor
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-334
P2A03
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow
Response (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
2. A/F sensor
3. ECM
Come on
DTC stored
ES-334
ES
Trouble Areas
MIL
ES–65
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0010
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator Circuit (Bank
1)
DTC
P0020
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator Circuit (Bank
2)
HINT:
These DTCs relate to the Oil Control Valve (OCV).
DESCRIPTION
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system includes the ECM, OCV and VVT controller. The ECM sends a
target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal regulates the oil pressure applied to the
VVT controller. Camshaft timing control is performed according to engine operating conditions such as
intake air volume, throttle valve position and engine coolant temperature.
The ECM controls the OCV, based on the signals transmitted by several sensors. The VVT controller
regulates the intake camshaft angle using oil pressure through the OCV. As a result, the relative positions
of the camshaft and crankshaft are optimized, the engine torque and fuel economy improve, and the
exhaust emissions decrease under overall driving conditions. The ECM detects the actual intake valve
timing using signals from the camshaft and crankshaft position sensors, and performs feedback control.
This is how the target intake valve timing is verified by the ECM.
Duty Control
ECM
Crankshaft Positon Sensor
Target Valve Timing
Mass Air Flow Meter
Camshaft
Timing OCV
Throttle Position Sensor
Feedback
Actual Valve Timing
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Correction
Vehicle Speed Signal
Camshaft Position Sensor
A071007E09
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P0010
Open or short in OCV circuit (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open or short in Oil Control Valve (OCV) circuit
OCV
ECM
P0020
Open or short in OCV circuit (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open or short in Oil Control Valve (OCV) circuit
OCV
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the VVT system to control the intake camshaft. The VVT
system includes the ECM, the OCV and the VVT controller. The ECM sends a target duty-cycle control
signal to the OCV. This control signal regulates the oil pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT
controller can advance or retard the intake camshaft.
After the ECM sends the target duty-cycle signal to the OCV, the ECM monitors the OCV current to
establish an actual duty-cycle. The ECM determines the existence of a malfunction and sets a DTC when
the actual duty-cycle ratio varies from the target duty-cycle ratio.
ES
ES–66
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0010: VVT OCV (Bank 1) range check
P0020: VVT OCV (Bank 2) range check
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT OCV (Variable Valve Timing Oil Control Valve)
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Starter
OFF
Ignition switch
ON
Time after ignition switch OFF to ON
0.5 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
One of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1, 2 or 3
1. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) Battery voltage
11 to 13 V
(b) Target duty ratio
Less than 70 %
(c) Output signal duty ratio
100 % or more
2. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (d), (e) and (f)
(d) Battery voltage
13 V or more
(e) Target duty ratio
Less than 80 %
(f) Output signal duty ratio
100 % or more
3. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (g) and (h)
(g) Current cut status
Not cut
(h) Output signal duty ratio
3 % or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
OCV current
3 % to 100 %
ES–67
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
C3
ECM
OCV (Bank 1)
G-Y
17
OC1+
E6
L-B
16
OC1E6
1
2
ES
C2
OCV (Bank 2)
L-W
15
OC2+
E6
L-R
14
OC2E6
1
2
A086808E26
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTC P0010 is displayed, check the bank 1 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that include cylinder No. 1.
• If DTC P0020 is displayed, check the bank 2 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not includes cylinder No. 1.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and turn the tester on.
Warm up the engine and idle it.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
VVT CTRL B1 or VVT CTRL B2.
(e) Check the engine speed while operating the Oil Control
Valve (OCV) using the tester.
ES–68
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard
Tester Operations
Specified Conditions
OCV OFF
Normal engine idle speed
OCV ON
Engine idles roughly or stalls (soon after OCV switched from OFF to ON)
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
2
ES
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY (OCV SIGNAL)
(a) Disconnect the C2 or C3 OCV connector.
(b) While idling, check the waveform between the terminals
of the C2 or C3 OCV connector using an oscilloscope.
OK
Wire Harness Side:
OCV Connector
C2
Bank 1
C3
Bank 2
+
Front View
Specified Conditions
+ (C2-1) - - (C2-2)
Correct waveform appears
+ (C3-1) - - (C3-2)
Correct waveform appears
(c) Reconnect the OCV connector.
OK
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A094633E45
NG
Tester Connections
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
ES–69
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
INSPECT ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a) Inspect the ECM using an oscilloscope.
(b) While idling, check the waveform between the terminals
of the E6 ECM connector.
OK
ECM:
E6
OC1+ OC1- OC2+ OC2-
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
OC1+ (E6-17) - OC1- (E6-16)
Correct waveform appears
OC2+ (E6-15) - OC2- (E6-14)
Correct waveform appears
NG
REPLACE ECM
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/Division
GND
1 msec./Division
G035623E09
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (OCV SIGNAL OPEN CIRCUIT)
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–1
SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
• Perform the RESET MEMORY (AT initialization)
when replacing the automatic transmission
assembly, engine assembly or ECM (See page AT19).
• Perform the REGISTRATION (VIN registration)
when replacing the ECM (See page ES-9).
HINT:
RESET MEMORY can not be completed by only
removing the battery.
FOR USING INTELLIGENT TESTER
NOTICE:
Observe the following items for safety reasons:
• Read its instruction books before using the tester.
• Prevent the tester cable from being caught on the
pedals, shift lever and steering wheel when
driving with the tester connected to the vehicle.
• When driving the vehicle for testing purposes
using the tester, two persons are required. One is
for driving the vehicle, and the other operates the
tester.
ES
ES–2
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Terms
ES
Definitions
Monitor Description
Description of what ECM monitors and how to detect malfunctions (monitoring purpose and details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by ECM based on the same malfunction detection logic.
Typical Enabling
Conditions
Preconditions that allow ECM to detect malfunction.
With all preconditions satisfied, ECM sets DTC when monitored value(s) exceeds malfunction threshold(s).
Sequence of Operation
Order of monitor priority, applied if multiple sensors and components involved in single malfunction detection
process.
Each sensor and component monitored in turn and not monitored until previous detection operation is completed.
Required Sensors /
Components
Sensors and components used by ECM to detect each malfunction.
Frequency of Operation
Number of times ECM checks for each malfunction during each driving cycle.
"Once per driving cycle" means ECM only performs checks for that malfunction once during single driving cycle.
"Continuous" means ECM performs checks for that malfunction whenever enabling conditions are met.
Duration
Minimum time for which ECM must detect continuous deviation in monitored value(s) in order to set DTC. Timing
begins when typical enabling conditions are met.
Malfunction Thresholds
Values, beyond which, ECM determines malfunctions exist and sets DTCs.
MIL Operation
Timing of MIL illumination after defect is detected.
"Immediate" means ECM illuminates MIL as soon as malfunction is detected.
"2 driving cycles" means ECM illuminates MIL if the same malfunction is detected twice during the next sequential
driving cycle.
ES–70
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0011
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Advanced
or System Performance (Bank 1)
DTC
P0012
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Retarded
(Bank 1)
DTC
P0021
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Advanced
or System Performance (Bank 2)
DTC
P0022
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Retarded
(Bank 2)
HINT:
If DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is present, check the VVT (Variable Valve Timing) system.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0010 (See page ES-59).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0011
P0021
Advanced cam timing:
With warm engine and engine speed of between 550
rpm and 4,000 rpm, all conditions (a), (b) and (c) are
met (1 trip detection logic):
(a) Difference between target and actual intake valve
timings is more than 5° CA (Crankshaft Angle) for 4.5
seconds
(b) Current intake valve timing is fixed (timing changes
less than 5° CA in 5 seconds)
(c) Variations in VVT controller timing are more than 19°
CA of maximum delayed timing (advanced)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
Valve timing
OCV
OCV filter
Intake camshaft timing gear assembly
ECM
P0012
P0022
Retarded cam timing:
With warm engine and engine speed of between 550
rpm and 4,000 rpm, all conditions (a), (b) and (c) are
met (2 trip detection logic):
(a) Difference between target and actual intake valve is
timings more than 5° CA (Crankshaft Angle) for 4.5
seconds
(b) Current intake valve timing is fixed (timing changes
less than 5° CA in 5 seconds)
(c) Variations in VVT controller timing is 19° CA or less
of maximum delayed timing (retarded)
•
•
•
•
•
Valve timing
OCV
OCV filter
Camshaft timing gear assembly
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the intake valve timing using the VVT (Variable Valve Timing) system to control the
intake camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller.
The ECM sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal regulates the oil
pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake camshaft.
If the difference between the target and actual intake valve timings is large, and changes in actual intake
valve timing are small, the ECM interprets this as the VVT controller stuck malfunction and sets a DTC.
Example:
A DTC will be set when the following conditions 1), 2) and 3) are met:
1) The difference between the target and actual intake valve timings is more than 5° CA (Crankshaft
Angle) and the condition continues for more than 4.5 seconds.
2) It takes 5 seconds or more to change the valve timing by 5° CA.
ES–71
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3) After above conditions 1) and 2) are met, the OCV is forcibly activated 63 times or more.
DTCs P0011 and P0021 (Advanced Cam Timing) are subject to 1 trip detection logic.
DTCs P0012 and P0022 (Retarded Cam Timing) are subject to 2 trip detection logic.
These DTCs indicate that the VVT controller cannot operate properly due to OCV malfunctions or the
presence of foreign objects in the OCV.
The monitor will not run unless the following conditions are met:
- The engine is warm (the engine coolant temperature is 75°C [167°F] or more).
- The vehicle has been driven at more than 40 mph (64 km/h) for 3 minutes.
- The engine has idled for 3 minutes.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0011: VVT system advance (Bank 1)
P0012: VVT system retard (Bank 1)
P0021: VVT system advance (Bank 2)
P0022: VVT system retard (Bank 2)
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT OCV, VVT Actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, Camshaft position sensor, ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycles
Duration
Less than 10 seconds
MIL operation
P0011 and P0021: Immediate
P0012 and P0022: 2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
ES
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF Sensor), P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT
Sensor), P0125 (Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop), P0335 (CKP Sensor), P0340
(VVT Sensor 1, 2), P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354, P0355, P0356 (Ignitor)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine RPM
500 to 4,000 rpm
ECT
75 to 100°C (167 to 212°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0011, P0021:
Duration of actual valve timing and target valve timing
More than 5° CA (Crankshaft angle)
Valve timing
No change at advanced valve timing
P0012, P0022:
Duration of actual valve timing and target valve timing
More than 5° CA (Crankshaft angle)
Valve timing
No change at retarded valve timing
If the difference between the target and actual camshaft timings is greater than the specified value, the
ECM operates the VVT actuator.
Then, the ECM monitors the camshaft timing change for 5 seconds.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0010 (See page ES-61).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Abnormal bank
Advanced timing over
(Valve timing is out of specified range)
Retarded timing over
(Valve timing is out of specified range)
Bank 1
P0011
P0012
Bank 2
P0021
P0022
ES–72
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
• If DTC P0011 or P0012 is displayed, check the bank 1 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• If DTC P0021 or P0022 is displayed, check the bank 2 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
ES
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 OR
P0022)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022
A
P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022
are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and turn the tester on.
Warm up the engine.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
VVT CTRL B1.
(e) Check the engine speed while operating the Oil Control
Valve (OCV) using the tester.
OK
Tester Operations
Specified Conditions
OCV OFF
Normal engine idle speed
OCV ON
Engine idles roughly or stalls (soon after OCV switched from OFF to ON)
NG
OK
Go to step 4
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 OR P0022)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine and warm it up.
Select check mode using the tester (See page ES-35).
Drive the vehicle for more than 10 minutes.
Read DTCs using the tester.
OK:
No DTC output.
NG
OK
END
ES–73
Go to step 4
ES
ES–74
4
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE AND JUMPED TEETH ON TIMING CHAIN)
Timing Mark
ES
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
(a) Remove the cylinder head covers RH and LH.
(b) Turn the crankshaft to align the matchmarks of the
crankshaft.
(c) Align the notch of the crankshaft pulley to the "0"
position.
(d) Check if the matchmarks of the camshaft pulley and
camshaft bearing cap align.
(e) Turn the crankshaft clockwise by 360° if the matchmarks
do not align. Check if they align once again.
OK:
The matchmarks of the camshaft pulley and the
camshaft bearing cap align when the notch of the
crankshaft pulley is in the "0" position.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
Timing Mark
A135015E01
OK
5
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY (OCV)
Valve Moves
A097066E08
(a) Remove the OCV.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
OCV.
Resistance:
6.9 to 7.9 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Apply the positive battery voltage to terminal 1 and
negative battery voltage to terminal 2. Check the valve
operation.
OK:
Valve moves quickly.
(d) Reinstall the OCV.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–75
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
OK
6
CHECK OIL PIPE AND OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK:
The filter is not clogged.
NG
REPLACE OIL PIPE OR OIL CONTROL
VALVE FILTER
ES
OK
7
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSEMBLY
NEXT
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on (IG) and turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine and warm it up.
Select the check mode using the tester (See page ES35).
(f) Drive the vehicle for more than 10 minutes.
(g) Confirm that no DTC is set using the tester.
OK:
No DTC output.
HINT:
DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is output when
foreign objects in engine oil are caught in some parts of
the system. These codes will stay registered even if the
system returns to normal after a short time. These
foreign objects are then captured by the oil filter, thus
eliminating the source of the problem.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE ECM
ES–76
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0016
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation (Bank 1 Sensor A)
DTC
P0018
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation (Bank 2 Sensor A)
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0335 (See page ES-185).
DTC No.
P0016
ES
P0018
DTC Detection Conditions
Deviations in crankshaft and camshaft position sensor
(for intake camshaft) 1 signals (2 trip detection logic)
Deviations in crankshaft and camshaft position sensor
(for intake camshaft) 2 signals (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Mechanical system (Timing chain has jumped tooth
or chain stretched)
ECM
Mechanical system (Timing chain has jumped tooth
or chain stretched)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing by using the VVT (Variable Valve Timing) system to control the intake
camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller.
The ECM sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal regulates the oil
pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake camshaft. The
ECM calibrates the intake valve timing by setting the intake camshaft to the most retarded angle while the
engine is idling. The ECM closes the OCV to retard the cam. The ECM stores this value as the VVT
learning value. When the difference between the target and actual intake valve timings is 5° CA
(Crankshaft Angle) or less, the ECM stores it.
If the VVT learning value matches the following conditions, the ECM determines the existence of a
malfunction in the VVT system, and sets the DTC.
• The VVT learning value: Less than 22.5° CA, or more than 45.2° CA.
• The above condition continues for 18 seconds or more.
This DTC indicates that the intake camshaft has been installed toward the crankshaft at an incorrect
angle, caused by factors such as the timing chain having jumped a tooth.
This monitor begins to run after the engine has idled for 5 minutes.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0016: Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and camshaft position sensor
signal (Bank 1)
P0018: Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and camshaft position sensor
signal (Bank 2)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
VVT actuator
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Camshaft position sensor, Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Less than 60 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0011, P0012 (VVT System1-Advance, Retard), P0021, P0022 (VVT System2Adavance, Retard), P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor),
Engine RPM
500 to 1,400 rpm
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–77
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0016 and P0018:
One of the following conditions is met
-
VVT learning value at maximum retarded valve timing (Bank 1)
Less than 22.5° CA (crankshaft angle)
VVT learning value at maximum retarded valve timing (Bank 1)
Less than 22.5° CA (crankshaft angle)
VVT learning value at maximum retarded valve timing (Bank 2)
More than 45.2° CA (crankshaft angle)
VVT learning value at maximum retarded valve timing (Bank 2)
More than 45.2° CA (crankshaft angle)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (See page ES-187).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
ES
ES–78
1
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE AND A JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING CHAIN)
Timing Mark
ES
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
(a) Remove the cylinder head covers RH and LH.
(b) Turn the crankshaft to align the matchmarks of the
crankshaft.
(c) Align the notch of the crankshaft pulley to the "0"
position.
(d) Check if the matchmarks of the camshaft pulley and
camshaft bearing cap align.
(e) Turn the crankshaft clockwise by 360° if the matchmarks
do not align. Check if they align once again.
OK:
The matchmarks of the camshaft pulley and the
camshaft bearing cap align when the notch of the
crankshaft pulley is in the "0" position.
NOTICE:
After replacing the ECM or adjusting intake valve
timing, confirm that the DTC output does not recur.
(f) Confirm that the DTC output does not recur.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch on (IG).
(3) Turn the tester on.
(4) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
(5) Select the check mode using the tester (See page
ES-35).
(6) Start the engine and warm it up.
(7) Allow the engine to idle for 1 minute or more, and
then drive the vehicle for 1 minute or more.
(8) Confirm that no DTC is set, using the tester.
NG
A135015E01
OK
REPLACE ECM
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
ES–79
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0031
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0032
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0051
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0052
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
ES
HINT:
• Although the DTC titles say the oxygen sensor, these DTCs relate to the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted in front of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and
located near the engine assembly.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-298).
HINT:
• When any of these DTCs are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. The ECM turns off the A/F sensor
heater in fail-safe mode. Fail-safe mode continues until the ignition switch is turned off.
• The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust the current through the heater. The
A/F sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 1):
A/F Sensor
Heater Relay
From
Battery
From EFI
Relay
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B
Heater
HT
HA1A
AF-
Sensor
AF+
A1A+
A/F Heater
Fuse
EFI No. 2
A1A-
Duty
Control
G035624E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P0031
P0051
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater current less than 0.8
A (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Open in A/F sensor heater circuit
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor heater relay
ECM
P0032
P0052
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater current more than 10
A (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Short in A/F sensor heater circuit
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor heater relay
ECM
ES–80
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
• Sensor 1 refers to the closest sensor to the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the furthest sensor away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
The ECM uses information from the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor to regulate the air-fuel ratio and keep it
close to the stoichiometric level. This maximizes the ability of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) to
purify the exhaust gas.
The A/F sensor detects oxygen levels in the exhaust gas and transmits the information to the ECM. The
inner surface of the sensor element is exposed to the outside air. The outer surface of the sensor element
is exposed to the exhaust gas. The sensor element is made of platinum coated zirconia and includes an
integrated heating element.
The zirconia element generates small voltage when there is a large difference in the oxygen
concentrations between the exhaust gas and outside air. The platinum coating amplifies this voltage
generation.
The A/F sensor is more efficient when heated. When the exhaust gas temperature is low, the sensor
cannot generate useful voltage signals without supplementary heating. The ECM regulates the
supplementary heating using a duty-cycle approach to adjust the average current in the sensor heater
element. If the heater current is outside the normal range, the signal transmitted by the A/F sensor will be
inaccurate, as a result, the ECM will be unable to regulate air-fuel ratio properly.
When the current in the A/F sensor heater is outside the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this
as a malfunction in the sensor heater and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECM sets DTC P0032 or P0052 when the current in the A/F sensor heater is more than 10 A.
Conversely, when the heater current is less than 0.8 A, DTC P0031 or P0051 is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0031: A/F sensor heater (Bank 1) range check (Low current)
P0032: A/F sensor heater (Bank 1) range check (High current)
P0051: A/F sensor heater (Bank 2) range check (Low current)
P0052: A/F sensor heater (Bank 2) range check (High current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor heater
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
P0031 and P0051:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
A/F sensor heater duty ratio
50% or more
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
P0032 and P0052:
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
ES–81
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0031 and P0051:
A/F sensor heater current
Less than 0.8 A
P0032 and P0052:
A/F sensor heater current
More than 10 A
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
A/F sensor heater resistance
WIRING DIAGRAM
ES
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-302).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side:
A/F Sensor
A12 Bank 1
A13 Bank 2
AF-
+B
Front View
HT
AF+
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
A085152E62
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F sensor heater relay from the engine
room R/B.
(b) Measure the A/F sensor heater relay resistance.
Standard resistance
B016200
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and
2)
(c) Reinstall the A/F sensor heater relay.
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR RELAY
ES–82
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (HA1A OR HA2A VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E5
ECM connector.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E5
ES
E04
E05
HA1A HA2A
A131509E32
Specified Conditions
HA1A (E5-2) - E04 (E5-7)
9 to 14 V
HA2A (E5-1) - E05 (E5-6)
9 to 14 V
HINT:
• The HA1A means the A/F sensor bank 1 sensor 1.
• The HA2A means the A/F sensor bank 2 sensor 1.
OK
NG
Tester Connections
REPLACE ECM
ES–83
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM, A/F SENSOR - A/F SENSOR
HEATER RELAY)
(a) Check the harness and the connector between the ECM
and the A/F sensor.
(1) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
A/F Sensor Connector
HT
+B
A12 Bank 1
A13 Bank 2
Front View
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
Below 1 Ω
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
E5
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(b) Check the harness and the connector between the A/F
sensor and engine room junction block (A/F sensor
heater relay).
(1) Remove the engine room junction block.
(2) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
HA2A
HA1A
ECM Connector
Engine Room R/B
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (A12-2) -A/F sensor heater relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
+B (A13-2) -A/F sensor heater relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A/F Sensor Heater Relay
A138714E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (A12-2) or A/F sensor heater relay (3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (A13-2) or A/F sensor heater relay (3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(3) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(4) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(5) Reinstall the A/F sensor heater relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–84
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0037
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit Low
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0038
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit High
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0057
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit Low
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0058
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit High
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0141
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0161
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
HINT:
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted behind the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and located
furthest from the engine assembly.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0136 (See page ES-128).
HINT:
• When any of these DTCs are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. The ECM turns off the Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater in fail-safe mode. Fail-safe mode continues until the ignition switch is
turned off.
• The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust the current through the heater. The
HO2 sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the B+ side of the circuit.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 2):
Engine Room Junction Block
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI No. 2
Fuse
ECM
HO2 Sensor
+B
EFI No. 1 Fuse
HT
HT1B
OX1B
OX1B
Heater
E1
Duty
Control
Sensor
Ground
E2
MREL
G042820E04
ES–85
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P0037
P0057
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater current is less
than 0.3 A (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Open in HO2 sensor heater circuit
HO2 sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0038
P0058
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater current is more
than 2 A (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
HO2 sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0141
P0161
Cumulative heater resistance correction value exceeds
the acceptable threshold. (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Open or short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
HO2 sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
HINT:
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor furthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The sensing portion of the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor has a zirconia element which is used to detect
the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas. If the zirconia element is at the appropriate temperature,
and the difference between the oxygen concentrations surrounding the inside and outside surfaces of the
sensor is large, the zirconia element generates voltage signals. In order to increase the oxygen
concentration detecting capacity of the zirconia element, the ECM supplements the heat from the exhaust
with heat from a heating element inside the sensor.
Heated oxygen sensor heater range check (P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058):
The ECM monitors the current applied to the O2 sensor heater to check the heater for malfunctions. If the
current is below the threshold value, the ECM will determine that there is an open circuit in the heater. If
the current is above the threshold value, the ECM will determine that there is a short circuit in the heater.
Example:
The ECM sets DTC P0038 or P0058 when the current in the HO2 sensor heater is more than 2 A.
Conversely, when the heater current is less than 0.3 A, DTC P0037 or P0057 is set.
Heated oxygen sensor heater performance (P0141 and P0161):
After the accumulated heater ON time exceeds 100 seconds, the ECM calculates the heater resistance
using the battery voltage and the current applied to the heater. If the resistance is above the threshold
value, the ECM will determine that there is a malfunction in the HO2S heater and set DTC P0141 and
P0161.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0037: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2) open/short (Low electrical
current)
P0038: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2) open/short (High electrical
current)
P0057: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2) open/short (Low electrical
current)
P0058: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2) open/short (High electrical
current)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
Required sensors / components (Sub)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous: P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058
Once per driving cycle: P0141, P0161
Duration
0.5 seconds: P0037, P0057
Within 1 second: P0038, P0058
10 seconds: P0141 and P0161
ES
ES–86
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL Operation
MIL operation Immediate: P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058
2 driving cycles: P0141 and P0161
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0037 and P0057 (Low current):
1. When all conditions below are met
ES
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more to less than 20 V
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
Active heater OFF control
Not operating
Active heater ON control
Not operating
Duration of following conditions are met
0.5 seconds or more
Heater OFF time
Less than 0.1 seconds
Heater current
Less than 0.3 A
2. Heater OFF time
1 second or more
3. When all condition below are met
-
Learned heater OFF current operation
Completed
Active heater OFF control
Not operating
Active heater ON control
Not operating
Heater OFF time
Less than 0.1 seconds
P0038 and P0058 (High current):
When one of following conditions is met:
Condition 1, 2 or 3
1. When all conditions below are met
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Starter
OFF
Catalyst monitoring active A/F control
Not operating
Active heater OFF control
Not operating
Active heater ON control
Not operating
2. When all conditions below are met:
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more to less than 20 V
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
Active heater OFF control
Not operating
Active heater ON control
Not operating
Heater OFF time
Less than 0.1 seconds
Heater current
2 A or more
3. Heater OFF time
1 second or more
P0141 and P0161:
When one of following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met:
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Fuel cut
OFF
Time after fuel cut ON to OFF
30 seconds or more
Accumulated heater ON time
100 seconds or more
Learned heater OFF current operation
Completed
2. Duration that rear heated oxygen sensor impedance
is less than 15 kΩ
2 seconds or more
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–87
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0037 and P0057 (Low current):
Heater current
Less than 0.3 A
P0038 and P0058 (High current):
When either condition below is met
-
Learned heater OFF current
More than 2 A
Heater current - Learned heater OFF current
2 A or more
P0141 and P0161 (Heater performance monitor check):
Accumulated heater resistance
Varies with sensor element temperature (Example: More than 23 ohm)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater current
0.4 to 1.0 A (when engine idles, HO2 sensor warmed up and battery voltage 11 to 14
V)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0136 (See page ES-135).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES
ES–88
1
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
HO2 sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
HO2 Sensor
H6
Bank 1
ES
HT
+B
E
OX
HO2 Sensor
+B
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E (4)
10 kΩ or higher
Bank 2
Front View
H8
Bank 2
Tester Connections
HT
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
NG
E
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OX
Front View
A126268E03
OK
2
INSPECT EFI RELAY
(a) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the EFI relay heater relay resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and 2
(c) Reinstall the EFI relay.
B016200
OK
NG
REPLACE EFI RELAY
ES–89
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
INSPECT ECM (HT1B OR HT2B VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E4, E5
and E6 ECM connector.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E4
HT1B (+)
E5
E6
HT2B (+)
E1 (-)
A131509E33
Specified Conditions
9 to 14 V
HT2B (E5-5) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
HINT:
• The HT1B means the heated oxygen sensor bank 1
sensor 2.
• The HT2B means the heated oxygen sensor bank 2
sensor 2.
OK
NG
Tester Connections
HT1B (E4-1) - E1 (E6-1)
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–90
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR - ECM, HEATED
OXYGEN SENSOR - EFI RELAY)
(a) Check the harness and the connector between the ECM
and the HO2 sensor.
(1) Disconnect the H6 or H8 HO2 sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 or E5 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
HO2 Sensor Connector
H6
Bank 1
H8
Bank 2
HT
ES
+B
Front View
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (H6-1) - HT1B (E4-1)
Below 1 Ω
HT (H8-1) - HT2B (E5-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (H6-1) or HT1B (E4-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (H8-1) or HT2B (E5-5) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E5
(b) Check the harness and the connector between the HO2
sensor and EFI relay.
(1) Inspect the EFI No. 2 fuse
• Remove the EFI No. 2 fuse from engine room R/
B.
• Check the EFI No. 2 fuse resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(2) Measure the resistance.
• Remove the engine room junction block.
Standard resistance (Check for open):
HT2B
HT1B
ECM Connector
Engine Room R/B
EFI Relay
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (H6-2) - EFI relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
+B (H8-2) - EFI relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short):
A138715E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (H6-2) or EFI relay (3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (H8-2) or EFI relay (3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(3) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
(4) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(5) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–91
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0100
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
DTC
P0102
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0103
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
The Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter is a sensor that measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle
valve. The ECM uses this information to determine the fuel injection time and to provide appropriate airfuel ratio. Inside the MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire which is exposed to the flow of intake air.
By applying a specific electrical current to the wire, the ECM heats it to a specific temperature. The flow of
incoming air cools both the wire and an internal thermistor, changing their resistance. To maintain a
constant current value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components in the MAF meter. The
voltage level is proportional to the air flow through the sensor, and the ECM uses it to calculate the intake
air volume.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire and the temperature sensor provide a bridge
circuit, and the power transistor is controlled so that the potentials of A and B remain equal to maintain the
predetermined temperature.
HINT:
When any of these DTCs are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ignition
timing is calculated by the ECM, according to the engine RPM and throttle valve position. Fail-safe mode
continues until a pass condition is detected.
B+
Temperature Sensor
(Thermistor)
Power Transistor
Platinum Hot Wire
(Heater)
A
B
Output
Voltage
Temperature Sensor
(Thermistor)
Platinum Hot Wire (Heater)
A094565E04
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P0100
Open or short in Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter circuit for 3
seconds
•
•
•
Open or short in MAF meter circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0102
Open in Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter circuit for 3
seconds
•
•
•
•
Open in MAF meter circuit
Short in ground circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0103
Short in Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter circuit for 3
seconds
•
•
•
Short in MAF meter circuit (+B circuit)
MAF meter
ECM
HINT:
When any of these DTCs are set, check the air-flow rate by selecting the following menu items on an
intelligent tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF.
ES
ES–92
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Mass Air Flow Rate (gm/s)
Approximately 0.0
271.0 or more
Malfunctions
•
•
Open in Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter power source circuit
Open or short in VG circuit
Open in EVG circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
If there is a defect in the MAF meter or an open or short circuit, the voltage level deviates from the normal
operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a malfunction in the MAF meter and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the sensor voltage output remains less than 0.2 V, or more than 4.9 V, for more than 3 seconds, the
ECM sets a DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 3 seconds after the engine is next started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0100: Mass air flow meter range check (Fluctuating)
P0102: Mass air flow meter range check (Low voltage)
P0103: Mass air flow meter range check (High voltage)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
MAF meter
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate: Engine RPM less than 4,000 rpm
2 driving cycles: Engine RPM 4,000 rpm or more
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0100:
Mass air flow meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V, or more than 4.9 V
P0102:
Mass air flow meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V
P0103:
Mass air flow meter voltage
More than 4.9 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Mass air flow meter voltage
Between 0.4 V and 2.2 V
ES–93
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B
Engine Room R/B
EFI Relay
2
2
EFI No. 2
5
3
2
1
2
B
2
1
L-W
2
2
2
L
12
IM1
W-B
2
17
IC3
L-W
A
L-W
1
+B
2
EFI
L-W
J4
J/C
Engine Room R/B
ECM
R-Y
30
E4
VG
E2G 2 R-W
29
E4
E2G
VG 3
1
2
M1
Mass Air Flow Meter
B J2
B
A
J/C
W-G
B J3
35
IC4
W-G
8
MREL
E8
W-B
Battery
EB
G032680E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MASS AIR FLOW RATE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF.
(e) Read the values displayed on the tester.
ES
ES–94
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Mass Air Flow Rate (gm/s)
Proceed to
0.0
A
271.0 or more
B
Between 1.0 and 270.0 (*1)
C
*1: The value must be changed when the throttle valve is
open or closed.
B
C
ES
Go to step 6
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER (POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the M1 Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the wire
harness side connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
MAF Meter Connector
M1
+B (+)
Front View
A054396E81
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (M1-1) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (VG VOLTAGE)
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E4
ECM connector.
HINT:
The transmission gear selector lever should be in the P
or N position and the A/C switch should be turned off.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E4
VG (+)
E2G (-)
A131509E36
Tester Connections
Conditions
Specified Conditions
VG (E4-30) - E2G (E429)
Engine idling
0.5 to 3.0 V
OK
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES–95
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
MAF Meter Connector
M1
1
2
3
4
5
Specified Conditions
Below 1 Ω
E2G (M1-2) - E2G (E4-29)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E2G
VG
Front View
ECM:
E4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VG (M1-3) or VG (E4-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
VG
Tester Connections
VG (M1-3) - VG (E4-30)
E2G
A114604E04
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–96
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - EFI RELAY)
Wire Harness Side:
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
M1
+B (+)
ES
Front View
(a) Inspect the EFI No. 2 fuse.
(1) Remove the EFI No. 2 fuse from the engine room R/
B.
(2) Measure the EFI No. 2 fuse resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(3) Reinstall the EFI No. 2 fuse.
(b) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(c) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room R/B.
(d) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (M1-1) - EFI relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (M1-1) or EFI relay (3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(e) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
(f) Reinstall the EFI relay.
EFI Relay
A138716E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
6
INSPECT ECM (SENSOR GROUND)
(a) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance
ECM:
E4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
E2G (E4-29) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
E2G
A131509E37
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES–97
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
MAF Meter Connector
M1
1
2
3
4
5
E2G
VG
Front View
Specified Conditions
Below 1 Ω
E2G (M1-2) - E2G (E4-29)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM:
E4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VG (M1-3) or VG (E4-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
VG
Tester Connections
VG (M1-3) - VG (E4-30)
E2G
A114606E02
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–98
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Range / Performance Problem
P0101
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0100 (See page ES-85).
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0101
Conditions (a), (b), (c), (d) and (e) are met (2 trip
detection logic):
(a) Engine running
(b) Engine coolant temperature 70°C (158°F) or higher
(c) Throttle Position (TP) sensor voltage 0.4 V or more
(d) Average engine load value ratio less than 0.85, or
more than 1.19 (varies with estimated engine load)
Average engine load value ratio = Average engine load
based on MAF meter output / Average engine load
estimated from driving conditions
(e) Average air-fuel ratio less than -20 %, or more than
20 %
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Air induction system
PCV hose connections
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The MAF meter is a sensor that measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM
uses this information to determine the fuel injection time and to provide an appropriate air-fuel ratio. Inside
the MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire which is exposed to the flow of intake air. By applying a
specific electrical current to the wire, the ECM heats it to a specific temperature. The flow of incoming air
cools both the wire and an internal thermistor, affecting their resistance. To maintain a constant current
value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components of the MAF meter. The voltage level is
proportional to the airflow through the sensor, and the ECM uses it to calculate the intake air volume.
The ECM monitors the average engine load value ratio to check the MAF meter for malfunctions. The
average engine load value ratio is obtained by comparing the average engine load calculated from the
MAF meter output to the average engine load estimated from the driving conditions, such as the engine
speed and the throttle opening angle. If the average engine load value ratio is below the threshold value,
the ECM determines that the intake air volume is low, and if the average engine load value ratio is above
the threshold value, the ECM determines that the intake air volume is high.
If this is detected in 2 consecutive driving cycles, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0101: Mass air flow meter rationality
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Mass air flow meter
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor, Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor and
Throttle Position (TP) sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
20 seconds or more
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340 (CMP sensor)
Throttle position (TP sensor voltage)
0.24 V or more
Engine
Running
ES–99
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine coolant temperature
70°C (158°F) or more
IAT sensor circuit
OK
ECT sensor circuit
OK
CKP sensor circuit
OK
TP sensor circuit
OK
Canister pressure sensor circuit
OK
EVAP leak detection pump
OK
EVAP vent valve
OK
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Both of following conditions 1 and 2 met
-
1. Averaged engine load value ratio
Less than 0.85, or more than 1.19 (varies with estimated engine load)
2. Averaged air-fuel ratio
Less than -20 %, or more than 20 %
ES
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0100 (See page ES-87).
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the mass air flow performance monitor.
Vehicle Speed
Approximately 100 km/h
(62 mph)
Idling
Time
Warming Up
20 seconds or more
A112632E02
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine, and warm it up until the engine coolant temperature reaches 70°C (158°F) or
higher.
Drive the vehicle at approximately 62 mph (100 km/h) for 20 seconds or more.
ES–100
7.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES and check if any DTCs (any pending DTCs) are set.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
ES
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0101)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0101
A
P0101 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0101 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK PCV HOSE CONNECTIONS
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and is not damaged.
NG
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0110
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
DTC
P0112
Intake Air Temperature Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0113
Intake Air Temperature Circuit High Input
ES–101
DESCRIPTION
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, mounted on the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter, monitors the IAT.
The IAT sensor has a built-in thermistor with a resistance that varies according to the temperature of the
intake air. When the IAT is low, the resistance of the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high,
the resistance drops. These variations in resistance are transmitted to the ECM as voltage changes (see
Fig. 1).
The IAT sensor is powered by a 5 V applied from the THA terminal of the ECM, via resistor R.
Resistor R and the IAT sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the IAT sensor
changes, according to changes in the IAT, the voltage at terminal THA also varies. Based on this signal,
the ECM increases the fuel injection volume when the engine is cold to improve drivability.
(Figure 1)
Resistance kΩ
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A056276E06
HINT:
When any of DTCs P0110, P0112 and P0113 are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe
mode, the IAT is estimated to be 20°C (68°F) by the ECM. Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition
is detected.
DTC No.
P0110
P0112
Proceed to
DTC Detection
Conditions
Trouble Area
Step 1
Open or short in Intake Air
Temperature (IAT) sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
ECM
Step 4
Short in Intake Air
Temperature (IAT) sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
ECM
ES
ES–102
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
P0113
Proceed to
Step 2
DTC Detection
Conditions
Open in Intake Air
Temperature (IAT) sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds (1
trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
ECM
HINT:
When any of these DTCs are set, check the IAT by selecting the following menu items on the intelligent
tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE AIR.
ES
Temperature Displayed
Malfunctions
-40°C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or higher
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the Intake Air Temperature (IAT).
When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction in the IAT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
If the sensor voltage output is -40°C (-40°F) for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM determines that there is an
open in the IAT sensor circuit, and sets DTC P0113. Conversely, if the voltage output is more than 140°C
(284°F) for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM determines that there is a short in the sensor circuit, and sets
DTC P0112.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 0.5 seconds after the engine is next started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0110: IAT sensor range check (Fluttering)
P0112: IAT sensor range check (Low voltage)
P0113: IAT sensor range check (High voltage)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
Required sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0110:
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
Less than 0.18 V or more than 4.91 V [More than 140°C (284°F), or less than -40°C
(-40°F)]
P0112:
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
Less than 0.18 V [More than 140°C (284°F)]
P0113:
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
More than 4.91 V [Less than -40°C (-40°F)]
ES–103
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
0.18 V to 4.91 V [-40 to 140°C (-40 to 284°F)]
WIRING DIAGRAM
M1 Intake Air Temperature Sensor
(Built into Mass Air Flow Meter)
ECM
5V
THA
R-B
22
E4
BR
28
E4
4
THA
R
ES
E2
5
E2
G035631E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCEDOBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE
AIR.
(e) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
Same as actual Intake Air Temperature (IAT).
Result
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40°C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or higher
B
Same as actual IAT
C
HINT:
• If there is an open circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -40°C (-40°F).
ES–104
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• If there is a short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates140°C (284°F) or higher.
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
ES
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
ECM
MAF Meter Connector
THA
E2
Wire Harness Side:
MAF Meter Connector
M1
OK
1
2
3
4
5
E2
THA
Front View
A114607E03
NG
(a) Disconnect the M1 Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
connector.
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the MAF meter wire
harness side connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch on.
(e) Turn the tester on.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE
AIR.
(g) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
140°C (284°F) or higher
(h) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW
METER
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN ECM)
MAF Meter Connector
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the B45 ECM
connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do visual and contact pressure checks
on the ECM connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch on.
(e) Turn the tester on.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE
AIR.
(g) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
140°C (284°F) or higher
(h) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
ECM
THA
E2
ECM:
E4
OK
THA
ES–105
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
E2
A114608E06
NG
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
MAF Meter Connector
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
ECM
THA
E2
A084869E47
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE
AIR.
(f) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(g) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
OK
NG
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW
METER
ES
ES–106
5
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN ECM)
MAF Meter Connector
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE
AIR.
(f) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ECM
THA
E2
ES
ECM:
OK
E4
A114609E05
NG
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0111
ES–107
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Gradient Too
High
DESCRIPTION
Fig. 1
Resistance
(kΩ)
Acceptable
Temperature
ES
(°C)
(°F)
A067628E14
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, mounted on the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter, monitors the IAT.
The IAT sensor has a built in thermistor with a resistance that varies according to the temperature of the
intake air. When the IAT is low, the resistance of the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high,
the resistance drops. These variations in resistance are transmitted to the ECM as voltage changes (See
Fig. 1).
The IAT sensor is powered by a 5 V supply from the THA terminal of the ECM, via resistor R.
Resistor R and the IAT sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the IAT sensor
changes, according to changes in the IAT, the voltage at terminal THA also varies. Based on this signal,
the ECM increases the fuel injection volume when the engine is cold to improve driveability.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0111
When either of following conditions met (2 trip detection
logic):
• The intake air temperature rise is large from the previous
trip warm-up to the following trip.
• When the change in the intake air temperature after
engine start is less than the threshold value.
Trouble Areas
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs OBD II monitoring based on the values from the intake air temperature sensor. If there
is no change of the sensor value within the normal range, the ECM will not be able to perform OBD II
monitoring or will misdiagnose that there is a malfunction in the sensor. The ECM detects the stuck intake
air temperature sensor value by performing monitoring after the ignition switch is turned to OFF or START.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0111: Intake air temperature sensor rationality (After engine stop)
P0111: Intake air temperature sensor rationality (After cold engine
start)
ES–108
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Sub)
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor and Mass Air Flow (MAF)
meter
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds or more
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
ES
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs are not present
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
After engine stop:
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
ECT sensor circuit
OK
ECT in previous driving cycle
70°C (158°F) or more
Accumulated MAF amount in previous driving cycle
3,070 g or more
ECT when 30 minutes elapsed after engine stop
20°C (68°F) or more
After cold engine start:
Key-off duration
5 hours
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
ECT sensor circuit
OK
ECT
70°C (158°F) or more
Accumulated MAF amount
3,070 g or more
One of the following conditions 1 or 2 is met:
-
1. Duration while engine load is low
120 seconds or more
2. Duration while engine load is high
10 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
After engine stop:
IAT change
Less than 1°C (2°F)
After cold engine start:
IAT change
Less than 1°C (2°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0110 (See page ES-97).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0111)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–109
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
P0111 and other DTCs
A
P0111
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0111 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
A
GO TO DTC CHART
ES
ES–12
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) must be input
into the replacement ECM.
HINT:
The VIN is a 17-digit alphanumeric vehicle identification
number. The intelligent tester is required to register the VIN.
1.
INPUT INSTRUCTIONS
(a) Explains the general VIN input instructions using the
intelligent tester.
(b) Intelligent tester
The arrow buttons (UP, DOWN, RIGHT and LEFT)
and numerical buttons (0 to 9) are used to input the
VIN.
(c) Cursor Operation
To move the cursor around the tester screen, press
the RIGHT and LEFT buttons.
(d) Alphabetical Character Input
(1) Press the UP and DOWN buttons to select the
desired alphabetical character.
(2) After selection, the cursor should move.
(e) Numeric Character Input
(1) Press the numerical button corresponding to
the number that you want to input.
(2) After input, the cursor should move.
HINT:
Numerical characters can be selected by using
the UP and DOWN buttons.
(f) Correction
(1) When correcting the input character(s), put the
cursor onto the character using the RIGHT or
LEFT buttons.
(2) Select or input the correct character using the
UP/DOWN buttons, or the numerical buttons.
(g) Finishing Input Operation
(1) Make sure that the input VIN matches the
vehicle VIN after input.
(2) Press the ENTER button on the tester.
2.
READ VIN (Vehicle Identification Number)
(a) Explains the VIN reading process in a flowchart.
Reading the VIN stored in the ECM is necessary
when comparing it to the VIN provided with the
vehicle.
(b) Read VIN using the intelligent tester.
(c) Check the vehicle's VIN.
(d) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(f) Turn the tester ON.
ES
ES–13
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(g) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / VIN.
Menu Screen:
Select VIN READ
ES
VIN Previously Stored
DTC P0630 Set
VIN Not Stored
17-digit VIN
displayed
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
A103812E03
3.
WRITE VIN
(a) Explains the VIN writing process in a flowchart.
This process allows the VIN to be input into the
ECM. If the ECM is changed, or the ECM VIN and
Vehicle VIN do not match, the VIN can be
registered, or overwritten in the ECM by following
this procedure.
(b) Write VIN using the intelligent tester.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(e) Turn the tester ON.
ES–14
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(f)
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / VIN.
Menu Screen:
Select VIN WRITE
ES
VIN Previously Stored
[NO]
[YES]
[YES]
[YES]
To Menu
Screen
17-digit VIN displayed
[NO]
Continue to next illustration
To Menu Screen
A103813E01
ES–15
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
New Registration
Input Instructions
[ENTER]
ES
[ENTER]
[ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input Error
[EXIT]
Continue to next illustration
A103814E03
ES–16
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES
A103815
ES–110
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0115
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit
DTC
P0117
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0118
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
ES
A thermistor is built into the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor, of which the resistance value
varies according to the ECT.
The structure of the sensor and its connection to the ECM are the same as those of the Intake Air
Temperature (IAT) sensor.
HINT:
When any of DTCs P0115, P0117 and P0118 are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe
mode, the ECT is estimated to be 80°C (176°F) by the ECM. Fail-safe mode continues until a pass
condition is detected.
DTC No.
P0115
P0117
P0118
DTC Detection
Conditions
Proceed to
Trouble Areas
Step 1
Open or short in Engine
Coolant Temperature
(ECT) sensor circuit for
0.5 seconds (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
•
Open or short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
Step 4
Short in Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT) sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
Step 2
Open in Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT) sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
HINT:
When any of these DTCs are set, check the ECT by selecting the following menu items on the intelligent
tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunctions
-40°C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or higher
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the ECT. The ECT sensor has a
thermistor with a resistance that varies according to the temperature of the engine coolant. When the
coolant temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the
resistance drops.
These variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output from the sensor. The ECM monitors the
sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the ECT. When the sensor output voltage deviates from
the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ECT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
If the sensor voltage output is -40°C (-40°F) for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM determines that there is an
open in the ECT sensor circuit, and sets DTC P0118. Conversely, if the voltage output is more than 140°C
(284°F) for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM determines that there is a short in the sensor circuit, and sets
DTC P0117.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 0.5 seconds after the engine is next started.
ES–111
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
P0115: ECT sensor range check (Fluttering)
P0117: ECT sensor range check (Low voltage)
P0118: ECT sensor range check (High voltage)
Related DTCs
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
ES
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0115:
Less than 0.14 V or more than 4.91 V [More than 140°C (284°F), or less than -40°C
(-40°F)]
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
P0117:
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
Less than 0.14 V [More than 140°C (284°F)]
P0118:
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
More than 4.91 V [Less than -40°C (-40°F)]
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
0.14 V to 4.91 V [-40 to 140°C (-40 to 284°F)]
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
E2
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
B-L
21
E4
THW
BR
28
E4
E2
2
1
G035631E02
ES–112
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE)
ES
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(e) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
Between 80°C and 97°C (176°F and 207°F) with
warm engine.
Result
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40°C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or higher
B
Between 80°C and 97°C (176°F and 207°F)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -40°C (-40°F).
• If there is a short circuit, the intelligent tester indicates
140°C (284°F) or higher.
B
C
A
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
ES–113
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
ECM
ECT Sensor
E2
THW
E2
Wire Harness Side:
ECT Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the E2 Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT)
sensor connector.
(b) Connect terminals 1 and 2 of the ECT sensor connector
on the wire harness side.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch on.
(e) Turn the tester on.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(g) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
140°C (284°F) or higher
(h) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
OK
E2
1
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE ENGINE
COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2
Front View
A114610E03
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN ECM)
ECT Sensor
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECT sensor connector.
(b) Connect terminals THW and E2 of the E4 ECM
connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do visual and contact pressure checks
on the ECM connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch on.
(e) Turn the tester on.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(g) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
140°C (284°F) or higher
(h) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
ECM
E2
THW
E2
ECM:
E4
OK
THW
E2
A114608E07
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–114
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
ECT Sensor
ES
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
ECM
E2
THW
E2
A084869E64
Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(f) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(g) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NG
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN ECM)
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(f) Read the value displayed on the tester.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ECM
ECT Sensor
E2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
THW
E2
ECM:
OK
E4
A114609E06
NG
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–115
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range /
Performance Problem
P0116
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-104).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0116
When either of following conditions met (2 trip detection
logic):
• When cold engine started and engine warmed up,
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor value
does not change.
• After warmed up engine stopped and then next cold
engine start performed, ECT sensor value does not
change.
Trouble Areas
•
•
Thermostat
ECT sensor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ECT sensor cold start monitor
When a cold engine start is performed and then the engine is warmed up, if the ECT sensor value does
not change, it is determined that a malfunction has occurred. If this is detected in 2 consecutive driving
cycles, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
ECT sensor soak monitor
If the ECT sensor value does not change after the warmed up engine is stopped and then the next cold
engine start is performed, it is determined that a malfunction has occurred. If this is detected in 2
consecutive driving cycles, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0116: ECT sensor cold start monitor
P0116: ECT sensor soak monitor
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
ECT sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor and Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ECT sensor cold start monitor:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0100 to P0103: MAF meter
P0110 to P0113: IAT sensor
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
1 second or more
ECT at engine start
Less than 60°C (140°F)
IAT sensor circuit
OK
Soak time
0 seconds or more
Accumulated MAF
1,484 g or more
Engine
Running
Fuel cut
OFF
Difference between ECT at engine start and IAT
Less than 40°C (72°F)
ECT sensor soak monitor:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0100 to P0103: MAF meter
P0110 to P0113: IAT sensor
ES
ES–116
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Soak time
5 hours or more
Either (a) or (b) condition met
-
(a) ECT
60°C (140°F) or more
(b) Accumulated MAF
2,105 g or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECT sensor cold start monitor:
ECT sensor value change
ES
Less than 5°C (9°F)
ECT sensor soak monitor:
Difference between current ECT sensor value and
previous ECT sensor value when engine stopped
Less than 3°C (9°F)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ECT
ECT sensor value changes in accordance with actual ECT
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If any of DTCs P0115, P0117, P0118 or P0125 are set simultaneously with DTC P0116, the ECT
sensor may have an open or a short circuit. Troubleshoot those DTCs first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0116)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read the DTC.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
P0116
A
P0116 and other DTCs
B
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT WATER INLET WITH THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the water inlet with thermostat.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–117
Standard:
80°C to 84°C (176°F to 183°F)
HINT:
In addition to the above check, confirm that the valve is
completely closed when the temperature is below the
standard.
(c) Reinstall the water inlet with thermostat.
NG
REPLACE WATER INLET WITH
THERMOSTAT
OK
REPLACE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES
ES–399
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
MASS AIR FLOW METER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
• Perform the MAF meter inspection according to the
procedures below.
• Only replace the MAF meter when both the LONG
FT#1 value and MAF value in the DATA LIST (with the
engine stopped) are not within the normal operating
range.
Intelligent Tester
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
G039021E01
CHECK MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a) Perform confirmation driving pattern.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Turn the tester ON.
(4) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-31).
(5) Start the engine and warm it up with all
accessory switches OFF (until the engine
coolant temperature is 75°C (167°F) or more).
(6) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (31 mph) or more
for 3 minutes or more *1.
(7) Let the engine idle with the accelerator pedal
fully released for 2 minutes or more *2.
(8) Perform steps *1 and *2 at least 3 times.
(Vehicle Speed)
*1
*1
*1
50 km/h (31 mph)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
*2
*2
*2
Warming up
*1: 3 to 5 minutes
*2: 2 minutes
A116436E27
(b) Read the value the using intelligent tester (LONG
FT#1).
(1) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
LONG FT#1.
ES
ES–400
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
(2) Read the values displayed on the tester.
Standard value:
Within -15 to +15 %
If the result is not within the specified range,
perform the inspection below.
(c) Read the value the using intelligent tester (MAF).
NOTICE:
• Turn off the engine.
• Perform the inspection with the vehicle
indoors and on a level surface.
• Perform the inspection of the MAF meter
while it is installed to the air cleaner case
(installed to the vehicle).
• During the test, do not use the exhaust air
duct to perform suction on the exhaust pipe.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to ACC.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON (do not run the
engine).
(3) Turn the tester ON.
(4) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
MAF.
(5) Wait 30 seconds, and read the values on the
intelligent tester.
Standard condition:
Less than 0.72 g/sec.
• If the result is not as specified, replace the
MAF meter.
• If the result is within the specified range,
inspect the cause of the extremely rich or
lean air fuel ratio (see page ES-73).
ES–118
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit
DTC
P0122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P0220
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit
DTC
P0222
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0223
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2135
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A" /
"B" Voltage Correlation
HINT:
These DTCs relate to the Throttle Position (TP) sensor.
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
This ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) does not use a throttle cable. The Throttle Position (TP)
sensor is mounted on the throttle body, and detects the opening angle of the throttle valve. This sensor is
a non-contact type, and uses Hall-effect elements, in order to yield accurate signals, even in extreme
driving conditions, such as at high speeds as well as very low speeds.
The TP sensor has two sensor circuits which each transmit a signal, VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to
detect the throttle valve angle and VTA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. The sensor signal
voltages vary between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the throttle valve opening angle, and are transmitted to
the VTA terminals of the ECM.
As the valve closes, the sensor output voltage decreases and as the valve opens, the sensor output
voltage increases. The ECM calculates the throttle valve opening angle according to these signals and
controls the throttle actuator in response to driver inputs. These signals are also used in calculations such
as air-fuel ratio correction, power increase correction and fuel-cut control.
ES–119
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fail-Safe Angle
Throttle Position
Sensor Output
Voltage (V)
5
VTA2
Throttle Position Sensor
2.55
2.25
ECM
Magnet
VTA1
0.93
0.69
IC No. 1
ES
6
VC
E2
84
Throttle Valve Opening Angle (degrees)
VTA1
VTA2
Usable Range
0
Note:
The throttle valve opening angle detected by the
sensor terminal VTA1 is expressed as percentages.
IC No. 2
Between 10% and 24%: Throttle valve fully closed
Magnet
Between 64% and 96%: Throttle valve fully open
Approximately 19%: Fail-safe angle (6°)
A019802E49
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0120
Output voltage of VTA1 quickly fluctuates beyond lower
and upper malfunction thresholds for 2 seconds (1 trip
detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
Throttle Position (TP) sensor (built into throttle
body)
ECM
Output voltage of VTA1 is 0.2 V or less for 2 seconds (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
Short in VTA1 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0123
Output voltage of VTA1 is 4.8 V or more for 2 seconds
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
Open in VTA1 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
Short between VC and VTA1 circuits
ECM
P0220
Output voltage of VTA2 quickly fluctuates beyond lower
and upper malfunction thresholds for 2 seconds (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
ECM
P0222
Output voltage of VTA2 is 1.75 V or less for 2 seconds
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
Short in VTA2 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0223
Output voltage of VTA2 is 4.8 V or more, and VTA1 is
between 0.2 V and 2.02 V, for 2 seconds (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
Open in VTA2 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
Short between VC and VTA2 circuits
ECM
P0122
•
ES–120
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P2135
Either condition (a) or (b) met (1 trip detection logic):
(a) Difference between output voltages of VTA1 and
VTA2 is 0.02 V or less for 0.5 seconds or more
(b) Output voltage of VTA1 is 0.2 V or less, and VTA2 is
1.75 V or less, for 0.4 seconds or more
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Short between VTA1 and VTA2 circuits
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
ECM
HINT:
• When any of these DTCs are set, check the throttle valve opening angle by selecting the following
menu items on the intelligent tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS /
THROTTLE POS AND THROTTLE POS #2.
• THROTTLE POS denotes the VTA1 signal (expressed in percentages), and THROTTLE POS #2
denotes the VTA2 signal (expressed in voltages).
Reference (Normal Condition)
ES
Tester Display
Accelerator Pedal Fully Released
Accelerator Pedal Fully Depressed
THROTTLE POS
10 to 24%
64 to 96%
THROTTLE POS #2
2.1 to 3.1 V
4.5 to 5.0 V
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the Throttle Position (TP) sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle. There are
several checks that the ECM performs to confirm the proper operation of the TP sensor.
• A specific voltage difference is expected between the sensor terminals, VTA1 and VTA2, for each
throttle valve opening angle. If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is incorrect, the ECM interprets
this as a malfunction in the sensor, and sets a DTC.
• VTA1 and VTA2 each have a specific voltage range. If VTA1 or VTA2 is outside the normal operating
range, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the sensor, and sets a DTC.
• VTA1 and VTA2 should never be close to the same voltage level. If VTA1 is within 0.02 V of VTA2, the
ECM determines that there is a short circuit in the sensor, and sets a DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 2 seconds after the engine is next started.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned to OFF, the fail-safe operation will
stop and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0120: Throttle position sensor 1 range check (Fluctuating)
P0122: Throttle position sensor 1 range check (Low voltage)
P0123: Throttle position sensor 1 range check (High voltage)
P0220: Throttle position sensor 2 range check (Fluctuating)
P0222: Throttle position sensor 2 range check (Low voltage)
P0223: Throttle position sensor 2 range check (High voltage)
P2135: Throttle position sensor range check (Correlation)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Throttle position sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Accelerator pedal ON: 2 seconds
Accelerator pedal OFF: 10 seconds
P2135: 0.5 seconds or 0.4 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence of Operation
ES–121
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Ignition switch
ON
Throttle control motor power
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0120:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less, or 4.535 V or more
P0122:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
P0123:
VTA1 voltage
4,535 V or more
P0220:
VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less, or 4.8 V or more
P0222:
VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less
P0223:
Both of the following conditions are met for 2 seconds
or more:
Condition 1 and 2
1. VTA1 voltage
0.2 to 2.02 V
2. VTA2 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2135:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 voltage
0.02 V or less
2. Both of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a) and (b)
(a) VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
(b) VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VTA1 voltage
0.69 to 3.96 V
VTA2 voltage
2.25 to 4.8 V
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 6° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed. If the accelerator pedal is fully depressed slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is turned to OFF.
ES
ES–122
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T2 Throttle Position Sensor (Built into Throttle with motor Body)
VC
VTA1
ES
VTA2
E2
5
19
E4
G-W
W
23
VC
E4
20
E4
G-B
4
3
L-R
R
6
ECM
BR
VTA1
VTA2
28
E4 E2
G032681E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (THROTTLE POS AND THROTTLE POS #2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the intelligent tester
on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS / THROTTLE
POS and THROTTLE POS #2.
(d) Check the values displayed on the tester.
Result
TP#1 (VTA1)
When AP Released
TP#2 (VTA2)
When AP Released
TP#1 (VTA1)
When AP
Depressed
TP#2 (VTA2)
When AP
Depressed
Trouble Areas
Proceed to
0%
Between 0 V and 0.2
V
0%
Between 0 V and 0.2
V
VC circuit open
A
100%
Between 4.5 V and
5.0 V
100 %
Between 4.5 V and
5.0 V
E2 circuit open
A
0% or 100%
Between 2.1 V and
3.1 V
(Fail-safe)
0% or 100%
Between 2.1 V and
3.1 V
(Fail-safe)
VTA1 circuit open or
ground short
A
ES–123
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TP#1 (VTA1)
When AP Released
TP#2 (VTA2)
When AP Released
TP#1 (VTA1)
When AP
Depressed
TP#2 (VTA2)
When AP
Depressed
Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Approx. 19%
(Fail-safe)
Between 0 V and 0.2
V, or 4.5 V and 5.0 V
Between 10% and
24%
(Fail-safe)
Between 0 V and 0.2
V, or 4.5 V and 5.0 V
VTA2 circuit open or
ground short
A
Between 10% and
24%
Between 2.1 V and
3.1 V
Between 64% and
96%
(Not fail-safe)
Between 4.5 V and
5.0 V
(Not fail-safe)
TP sensor circuit
normal
B
HINT:
• TP#1 denotes THROTTLE POS, and TP#2 denotes
THROTTLE POS#2.
• AP denotes Accelerator Pedal.
• VTA1 is expressed as percentage, and VTA2 is
expressed as voltage.
B
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle with motor body connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Throttle with Motor Body Connector
T2
Tester Connections
1
E2
2
3
4
5
6
VTA2 VC
Front View
VTA1
ECM:
Below 1 Ω
Below 1 Ω
VTA2 (T2-4) - VTA2 (E4-19)
Below 1 Ω
E2 (T2-3) - E2 (E4-28)
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VC (T2-5) or VC (E4-23) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VTA1 (T2-6) or VTA1 (E4-20) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VTA2 (T2-4) or VTA2 (E4-19) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the throttle with motor body connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
VTA2
E2
NG
VTA1
A114611E03
OK
VC (T2-5) - VC (E4-23)
VTA1 (T2-6) - VTA1 (E4-20)
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E4
VC
Specified Conditions
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–124
3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle with motor body connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E4
ECM connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
Throttle with Motor Body Connector
T2
1
E2
ES
2
3
4
VTA2
5
6
VC
VTA
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VC (T2-23) - E2 (E4-28)
4.5 to 5.0 V
(d) Reconnect the throttle with motor body connector.
Front View
NG
REPLACE ECM
ECM:
E4
VC (+)
E2 (-)
A114612E03
OK
4
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the throttle with motor body assembly (See
page ES-413).
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine.
Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds or more.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 and/or P2135
A
No output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–125
A
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–126
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit Range / Performance Problem
P0121
HINT:
This DTC relates to the Throttle Position (TP) sensor.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 (See page ES-112).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0121
Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 voltages less than
0.8 V, or more than 1.6 V for 2 seconds (1 trip detection
logic)
ES
Trouble Areas
TP sensor (built into throttle body)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the TP sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
This sensor transmits two signals: VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and
VTA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. The ECM performs several checks to confirm the proper
operation of the TP sensor and VTA1.
For each throttle opening angle, a specific voltage difference is expected between the outputs of VTA1
and VTA2. If the voltage output difference between the two signals deviates from the normal operating
range, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the TP sensor. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, the DTC is set 2 seconds after the engine is next started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0121: TP sensor rationality
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
TP sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Either of following conditions A or B is met
-
A. Ignition switch
ON
B. Electric throttle motor power
ON
TP sensor malfunction (P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220,
P0222, P0223, P02135)
Not detected
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of following conditions is met
-
"Difference of TP sensor voltage between VTA1 and
VTA2 x 0.8"
Higher than 1.6 V
"Difference of TP sensor voltage between VTA1 and
VTA2 x 0.8"
Lower than 0.8 V
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–127
FAIL-SAFE
When this DTC, as well as other DTCs relating to ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
malfunctions, is set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 6° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed. If the accelerator pedal is fully depressed slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned off.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the throttle body assembly (See page ES-412).
NEXT
END
ES
ES–128
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Insufficient Coolant Temperature for Closed
Loop Fuel Control
P0125
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-104).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
•
ES
•
P0125
•
Case 1:
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) less than 19.45°C (-3°F) at engine start and following
conditions met (2 trip detection logic):
(a) 20 minutes elapsed since engine start
(b) ECT sensor value remains below closed-loop
fuel control enabling temperature
Case 2:
ECT between -19.45°C and -8.34°C (-3°F and
17°F) at engine start and following conditions met
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) 105 seconds elapsed since engine start
(b) ECT sensor value remains below closed-loop
fuel control enabling temperature
Case 3:
ECT above -8.34°C (17°F) at engine start and
following conditions met (2 trip detection logic):
(a) 61 seconds elapsed since engine start
(b) ECT sensor value remains below closed-loop
fuel control enabling temperature
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Cooling system
ECT sensor
Thermostat (water inlet)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The resistance of the ECT sensor varies in proportion to the actual ECT. The ECM supplies a constant
voltage to the sensor and monitors the signal output voltage of the sensor. The signal voltage output
varies according to the changing resistance of the sensor. After the engine is started, the ECT is
monitored through this signal. If the ECT sensor indicates that the engine is not yet warm enough for
closed-loop fuel control, despite a specified period of time having elapsed since the engine was started,
the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the sensor or cooling system and sets the DTC.
Example:
The ECT is 0°C (32°F) at engine start. After 5 minutes running time, the ECT sensor still indicates that the
engine is not warm enough to begin closed-loop fuel (air-fuel ratio feedback) control. The ECM interprets
this as a malfunction in the sensor or cooling system and sets the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0125: Insufficient engine coolant temperature for closed-loop fuel control
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Thermostat, Cooling system, ECT sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Engine coolant temperature sensor and mass air flow meter
Frequency of Operation
MAF meter
Duration
61 seconds: Engine coolant temperature at engine start -8.34°C (17°F) or more
105 seconds: Engine coolant temperature at engine start -19.45 to -8.34°C (-3 to
17°F)
20 minutes: Engine coolant temperature at engine start less than -19.45°C (-3°F)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF meter), P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT sensor),
P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT sensor)
Thermostat fail
Not detected
ES–129
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Time until "engine coolant temperature" detection
temperature reaches feedback start temperature
-
When the temperature at the time of engine starting is 8.34°C (17°F) or more
Engine coolant temperature is less than "closed-loop enable temperature" when 61
seconds or more after engine start
When the temperature at the time of engine starting is 19.45 to -8.34°C (-3 to 17°F)
Engine coolant temperature is less than "closed-loop enable temperature" when 105
seconds or more after engine start
When the temperature at the time of engine starting is 19.45°C (-3°F) or less
Engine coolant temperature is less than "closed-loop enable temperature" when 20
minutes. or more after engine start
WIRING DIAGRAM
ES
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-105).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If any of DTCs P0115, P0116, P0117 or P0118 are set simultaneously with DTC P0125, the Engine
Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor may have an open or a short circuit. Troubleshoot those DTCs first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0125)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0125
A
P0125 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0125 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat (See page CO-14).
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat
(See page CO-14).
Standard:
80° to 84°C (176° to 183°F)
ES–130
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
In addition to the above check, confirm that the valve is
completely closed when the temperature is below the
standard.
(c) Reinstall the thermostat (See page CO-15).
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
OK
3
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
(a) Check for defects in the cooling system that might cause
the system to be too cold, such as abnormal radiator fan
operation or any modifications.
ES
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES–131
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Coolant Thermostat (Coolant Temperature
Below Thermostat Regulating Temperature)
P0128
HINT:
This DTC relates to the thermostat.
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is set when the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) does not reach 75°C (167°F) despite
sufficient engine warm-up time.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0128
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met for 5 seconds (2 trip
detection logic):
(a) Cold start
(b) Engine warmed up
(c) ECT less than 75°C (167°F)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Thermostat
Cooling system
ECT sensor
ECM
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Estimated ECT
5 Seconds
Threshold
(75°C (167 °F))
Indicated ECT reading
ECT
Time
DTC set (after 2 driving cycle)
A082385E14
The ECM estimates the ECT based on the starting temperature, engine loads, and engine speeds. The
ECM then compares the estimated temperature with the actual ECT. When the estimated ECT reaches
75°C (167°F), the ECM checks the actual ECT. If the actual ECT is less than 75°C (167°F), the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction in the thermostat or the engine cooling system and sets the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0128: Coolant Thermostat
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor, Thermostat
ES–132
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
900 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0010, P0020 (VVT VSV 1, 2), P0011, P0012 (VVT System1-Advance, Retard),
P0021, P0022 (VVT System2-Adavance, Retard), P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/
F Sensor heater Sensor 1), P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF Meter), P0110,
P0112, P0113 (IAT Sensor), P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor), P0125
(Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop), P0171,P0172 (Fuel System), P0300, P0301,
P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306 (Misfire), P0335 (CKP Sensor), P0340 (CMP
Sensor), P0340, P0342, P0343, P0345 (VVT Sensor1, 2), P0351, P0352, P0353,
P0354, P0355, P0356 (Ignitor), P0500 (VSS), P2196, P2198(A/F Sensor
(Rationality)), P2A00, P2A03 (A/F Sensor (Slow Response))
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Either of following conditions met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of following conditions met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine starts
-15° to 7°C (5° to 45°F)
(b) ECT at engine start
-10° to 56°C (14° to 133°F)
(c) IAT at engine start
-10° to 56°C (14° to 133°F)
2. All of following conditions met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
More than 7°C (45°F)
(b) ECT at engine start
56°C (133°F) or less
(c) IAT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or more
Accumulated time that vehicle speed is 80 mph
(128km/h) or more
Less than 20 seconds
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Duration that all of following conditions 1 and 2 met
5 seconds or more
1. Estimated ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
2. ECT sensor output
Below 75°C (167°F)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to Checking Monitor Status (See page ES-14).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0128)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Turn the tester on.
ES–133
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0128
A
P0128 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0128 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
ES
A
2
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
(a) Check that there is no defect in the cooling system which
causes overcool, such as abnormal radiator fan
operation, modified cooling system and so on.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat (See page CO-14).
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat
(See page CO-14).
Standard:
80° to 84°C (176° to 183°F)
HINT:
In addition to the above check, confirm that the valve is
completely closed when the temperature is below the
standard.
(c) Reinstall the thermostat (See page CO-15).
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
ES–134
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0136
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0137
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0138
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0156
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0157
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0158
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
HINT:
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted behind the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and located far
from the engine assembly.
DESCRIPTION
In order to obtain a high purification rate of the carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and nitrogen
oxide (NOx) components in the exhaust gas, a TWC (Three-Way Catalytic Converter) is used. For the
most efficient use of the TWC, the air-fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to
the stoichiometric air-fuel level. For helping the ECM to deliver accurate air-fuel ratio control, a Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor is used.
The HO2 sensor is located behind the TWC, and detects the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas.
Since the sensor is integrated with the heater that heats the sensing portion, it is possible to detect the
oxygen concentration even when the intake air volume is low (the exhaust gas temperature is low).
When the air-fuel ratio becomes lean, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas is rich. The HO2
sensor informs the ECM that the post-TWC air-fuel ratio is lean (low voltage, i.e. less than 0.45 V).
Conversely, when the air-fuel ratio is richer than the stoichiometric air-fuel level, the oxygen concentration
in the exhaust gas becomes lean. The HO2 sensor informs the ECM that the post-TWC air-fuel ratio is
rich (high voltage, i.e. more than 0.45 V). The HO2 sensor has the property of changing its output voltage
drastically when the air-fuel ratio is close to the stoichiometric level.
The ECM uses the supplementary information from the HO2 sensor to determine whether the air-fuel ratio
after the TWC is rich or lean, and adjusts the fuel injection time accordingly. Thus, if the HO2 sensor is
working improperly due to internal malfunctions, the ECM is unable to compensate for deviations in the
primary air-fuel ratio control.
ES–135
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Atmospheric Air
Ideal Air-Fuel Mixture
Housing
Output Voltage
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum Electrode
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
Cover
ES
Richer - Air-Fuel Ratio - Leaner
Exhaust Gas
A088111E10
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
•
P0136
P0156
•
•
P0137
P0157
•
•
P0138
P0158
•
Abnormal voltage output:
During active air-fuel ratio control, following
conditions (a) and (b) are met for certain period of
time (2 trip detection logic):
(a) Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor voltage does not
decrease to less than 0.21 V
(b) HO2 sensor voltage does not increase to more
than 0.6 V
Low impedance:
Sensor impedance less than 5 Ω for more than 30
seconds when ECM presumes sensor to being
warmed up and operating normally (2 trip detection
logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
circuit
HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
HO2 sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
EFI relay
Gas leakage from exhaust system
Low voltage (open):
During active air-fuel ratio control, following
conditions (a) and (b) are met for certain period of
time (2 trip detection logic):
(a) HO2 sensor voltage output less than 0.21 V
(b) Target air-fuel ratio rich
High impedance:
Sensor impedance 15 kΩ or more for more than 90
seconds when ECM presumes sensor to being
warmed up and operating normally (2 trip detection
logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open in HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2) circuit
HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
HO2 sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
EFI relay
Gas leakage from exhaust system
High voltage (short):
During active air-fuel ratio control, following
conditions (a) and (b) are met for certain period of
time (2 trip detection logic):
(a) HO2 sensor voltage output 0.59 V or more
(b) Target air-fuel ratio lean
Extremely high voltage (short):
HO2 sensor voltage output exceeds 1.2 V for more
than 30 seconds (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Short in HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2) circuit
HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM internal circuit malfunction
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Active Air-Fuel Ratio Control
The ECM usually performs air-fuel ratio feedback control so that the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor output
indicates a near stoichiometric air-fuel level. This vehicle includes active air-fuel ratio control in addition to
regular air-fuel ratio control. The ECM performs active air-fuel ratio control to detect any deterioration in
the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor malfunctions (refer to the
diagram below).
ES–136
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Active air-fuel ratio control is performed for approximately 15 to 20 seconds while driving with a warm
engine. During active air-fuel ratio control, the air-fuel ratio is forcibly regulated to become lean or rich by
the ECM.
If the ECM detects a malfunction, one of the following DTCs is set: DTC P0136 or P0156 (abnormal
voltage output), P0137 or P0157 (open circuit) or P0138 or P0158 (short circuit).
Abnormal Voltage Output of HO2 Sensor (DTCs P0136 and P0156)
While the ECM is performing active air-fuel ratio control, the air-fuel ratio is forcibly regulated to become
rich or lean. If the sensor is not functioning properly, the voltage output variation is small. For example,
when the HO2 sensor voltage does not decrease to less than 0.21 V or does not increase to more than
0.59 V during active air-fuel ratio control, the ECM determines that the sensor voltage output is abnormal
and sets DTCs P0136 and P0156.
HO2 SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION )
ES
15 to 20 seconds
(P0136 and P0156: ABNORMAL VOLTAGE)
Operation
Active air-fuel
ratio control
Off
Normal
0.59 V
HO2 sensor
voltage
Abnormal
0.21 V
A076837E08
Open or Short in Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor Circuit (DTCs P0137 and P0157 or P0138 and
P0158)
During active air-fuel ratio control, the ECM calculates the Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC)* of the ThreeWay Catalytic Converter (TWC) by forcibly regulating the air-fuel ratio to become rich or lean.
If the HO2 sensor has an open or short, or the voltage output of the sensor noticeably decreases, the
OSC indicates an extraordinarily high value. Even if the ECM attempts to continue regulating the air-fuel
ratio to become rich or lean, the HO2 sensor output does not change.
While performing active air-fuel ratio control, when the target air-fuel ratio is rich and the HO2 sensor
voltage output is 0.21 V or less (lean), the ECM interprets this as an abnormally low sensor output voltage
and sets DTC P0137 or P0157. When the target air-fuel ratio is lean and the voltage output is 0.59 V or
more (rich) during active air-fuel ratio control, the ECM determines that the sensor voltage output is
abnormally high, and sets DTC P0138 or P0158.
HINT:
DTC P0138 or P0158 is also set if the HO2 sensor voltage output is more than 1.2 V for 30 seconds or
more.
*: The TWC has the capability to store oxygen. The OSC and the emission purification capacity of the
TWC are mutually related. The ECM determines whether the catalyst has deteriorated, based on the
calculated OSC value (See page ES-205).
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HO2 SENSOR CIRCUIT LOW VOLTAGE (P0137 and P0157: OPEN)
Active air-fuel
ratio control
Target air-fuel ratio
Off
15 to 20 seconds
Operation Abnormal
Normal
Stoichiometric
Air-Fuel Level
Rich
HO2 sensor
voltage
ES–137
Normal
ES
0.21 V
Abnormal
HO2 SENSOR CIRCUIT HIGH VOLTAGE (P0138 and P0158: SHORT)
Operation
Active air-fuel
ratio control
Target air-fuel ratio
HO2 sensor
voltage
Off
Lean
Stoichiometric
Air-Fuel Level
Abnormal
0.59 V
A080024E08
ES–138
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
High or Low Impedance of Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor (DTCs P0136 and P0156 or P0137 and
P0157)
During normal air-fuel ratio feedback control, there are small variations in the exhaust gas oxygen
concentration. In order to continuously monitor the slight variation of the HO2 sensor signal while the
engine is running, the impedance* of the sensor is measured by the ECM. The ECM determines that there
is a malfunction in the sensor when the measured impedance deviates from the standard range.
*: The effective resistance in an alternating current electrical circuit.
Interrelation between temperature of
element and impedance:
Impedance Ω
ES
DTC Detection Area
15,000
1,000
100
10
5
300 400
500
600
700
800
(572) (752) (932) (1,112) (1,292) (1,472)
Temperature °C (°F)
A076841E08
HINT:
• The impedance cannot be measured using an ohmmeter.
• DTCs P0136 and P0156 indicate the deterioration of the HO2 sensor. The ECM sets the DTCs by
calculating the impedance of the sensor when the typical enabling conditions are satisfied (1 driving
cycle).
• DTCs P0137 and P0157 indicate an open or short circuit in the HO2 sensor (1 driving cycle). The ECM
sets the DTCs when the impedance of the sensor exceeds the threshold 15 kΩ.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0136: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage) (bank 1)
P0136: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low) (bank 1)
P0137: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Low voltage) (bank 1)
P0137: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High) (bank 1)
P0138: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (High voltage) (bank 1)
P0138: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Extremely high) (bank 1)
P0156: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage) (bank 2)
P0156: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low) (bank 2)
P0157: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Low voltage) (bank 2)
P0157: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High) (bank 2)
P0158: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (High voltage) (bank 2)
P0158: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Extremely high) (bank 2)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Heated oxygen sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, Engine coolant temperature sensor, Mass air flow meter,
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle: Active air-fuel ratio control detection
Continuous: Others
Duration
20 seconds.: Heated oxygen sensor output (Output voltage, High voltage, Low
voltage)
30 seconds.: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low)
90 seconds.: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High)
10 seconds.: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Stuck high)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–139
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor runs whenever DTCs not present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 (O2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0306 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340 (CMP sensor)
P0450 - P0456 (EVAP System)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor - rationality)
P2A00, P2A03 (A/F sensor - slow response)
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage, High voltage and Low voltage):
Active air-fuel ratio control
Performing
Active air-fuel ratio control begins when all of following
conditions met:
-
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine coolant temperature
75°C (167°F) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine RPM
Less than 3,200 rpm
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed loop
Fuel-cut
OFF
Engine load
10 to 70%
Shift position
4th or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Estimated HO2S temperature
Less than 700°C (1,292°F)
ECM monitor
Completed
DTC P0606
Not set
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Estimated HO2S temperature
520 to 750°C (968 to 1,382°F)
DTC P0606
Not present
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Extremely high):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Time after engine start
2 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage):
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met
-
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or less
(b) Rear HO2 sensor voltage
0.21 to 0.59 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of Catalyst)
2.5 g or more
2. All of the following conditions (d), (e) and (f) are met.
-
(d) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.9 or more
ES
ES–140
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(e) Rear HO2 sensor voltage
0.21 to 0.59 V
(f) OSC
2.5 g or more
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Low output voltage):
All of the following conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met.
-
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or less
(b) Rear HO2 sensor voltage
Less than 0.21 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of Catalyst)
2.5 g or more
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (High output voltage):
ES
All of the following conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met.
-
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or more
(b) Rear HO2 sensor voltage
More than 0.59 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of Catalyst)
2.5 g or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low):
Duration of following condition
30 seconds or more
Rear heated oxygen sensor impedance
Less than 5 Ω
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High):
Duration of following condition
90 seconds or more
Rear heated oxygen sensor impedance
15 kΩ or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Extremely high):
Duration of following condition
10 seconds or more
Rear heated oxygen sensor voltage
1.2 V or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Heated oxygen sensor voltage
Varies between 0.1 and 0.9 V
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES–141
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
17
IC3
L-W
12
IM1
L-W
L-W
A
BR
J4
J/C
L-W
A L-W
2
2
L-W
EFI
No. 2 Engine Room R/B
ECM
2 +B
HT 1
G
1 HT1B
E4
4 E1
OX 3
W
18
E4 OX1B
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
2 +B
HT 1
BR 4 E1
OX 3
(*1)
5 HT2B
E5
L
33
E5 OX2B
B
1
ES
(*1)
2
W-G
B
2
2
3
35
IC4
W-G
28
E4
BR
1
EFI
Relay
8
MREL
E8
E2
Engine Room R/B
2
5
2
2
*1: Shielded
W-B
L
E
2
E
Engine Room
R/B
2
J28
J/C
B J2
EFI
1
E
J/C
B J3
BR
2
W-B
B
Battery
EB
EE
G032682E01
ES–142
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
• This confirmation driving pattern is used in steps 5, 8 and 11 of the following diagnostic troubleshooting
procedure when using the intelligent tester.
• Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor monitor. (The
catalyst monitor is performed simultaneously.) This is very useful for verifying the completion of a
repair.
Engine Speed
NOTICE:
“H”
This test will not be completed if the
vehicle is driven under absolutely
constant speed condition such as with
cruise control activated.
Between 40 mph and
70 mph (64 km/h and
113 km/h)
ES
Idling
Ignition Switch off
“G”
Warm up
10 minutes
Time
(Note: Even when vehicle stops during driving pattern, the test can be resumed)
A079199E76
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (Procedure A).
A098191E04
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Turn the ignition switch on (Procedure B).
Turn the tester on (Procedure C).
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31) (Procedure D).
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / CARB OBD II / READINESS TESTS (Procedure E).
Check that O2S EVAL is INCMPL (incomplete) (Procedure F).
Start the engine and warm it up (Procedure G).
Drive the vehicle at between 40 mph and 70 mph (64 km/h and 113 km/h) for at least 10 minutes
(Procedure H).
9. Note the state of the Readiness Tests items. Those items will change to COMPL (complete) as O2S
EVAL monitor operates (Procedure I).
10.On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES and check if any DTCs (any pending DTCs) are set (Procedure J).
HINT:
If O2S EVAL does not change to COMPL, and any pending DTCs fail to set, extend the driving time.
ES–143
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
For use of the intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester on.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. Select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection
volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
3
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
ES
ES–144
Case
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
•
•
•
4
ES
Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air-fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
– Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check the graph of the voltage
outputs of both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
– To display the graph, select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD
II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2. Press the YES button and then the ENTER button. Then press the F4 button.
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are
output simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving
condition information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting,
freeze frame data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped,
whether the engine was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as
other data recorded at the time of a malfunction.
• If the OX1B wire from the ECM connector is short-circuited to the +B wire, DTC P0136 will be
set.
• If the OX2B wire from the ECM connector is short-circuited to the +B wire, DTC P0156 will be
set.
1
READ DTC OUTPUT
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0138 or P0158
A
P0137 or P0157
B
P0136 or P0156
C
B
Go to step 13
C
Go to step 6
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
ES–145
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / O2S
B1S2 or O2S B2S2.
(d) Allow the engine to idle.
(e) Read the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor output voltage
while idling.
Result
HO2 Sensor Output Voltages
Proceed to
More than 1.2 V
A
Less than 1.0 V
B
B
Go to step 5
ES
A
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a) Turn the ignition switch off and wait for 5 minutes.
(b) Disconnect the E4 or E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance
ECM:
E4
HT1B
E5
OX2B
OX1B
Specified Conditions
HT1B (E4-1) - OX1B (E4-18)
10 kΩ or higher
HT2B (E5-5) - OX2B (E5-33)
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
HT2B
G035620E13
OK
NG
Tester Connections
REPLACE ECM
ES–146
4
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
HO2 sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
HO2 Sensor
H6
Bank 1
ES
HT
+B
E1
OX
HO2 Sensor
+B
Specified Conditions
+B (2) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
+B (2) - OX (3)
10 kΩ or higher
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (2) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
+B (2) - OX (3)
10 kΩ or higher
Bank 2:
Front View
H8
Bank 2
Tester Connections
HT
(c) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OX
E1
Front View
A126268E04
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
5
CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
HINT:
This A/F sensor test is to check the A/F sensor current during
the fuel-cut. When the sensor is normal, the sensor current
will indicate below 3 mA in this test.
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Drive the vehicle by the drive pattern as listed below:
(1) Warm up the engine.
(2) Drive the vehicle at 60 km/h (40 mph) or more for 10
minutes or more.
(3) Stop the vehicle.
(4) Accelerator the vehicle until 60 km/h (40 mph) or
more and decelerate for 3 seconds or more.
Perform this three times.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–147
Drive Pattern:
40 mph
(60 km/h)
0 mph
(0 km/h)
ES
10 minutes or more
3 seconds or more 3 seconds or more 3 seconds or more
A152792E01
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / MONITOR INFO / MONITOR RESULT.
(d) Confirm that RANGE B1S1 is either PASS or FAIL.
(e) Select RANGE B1S1 an press ENTER.
(f) Read the test value.
Standard:
Less than 3.0 mA
NOTICE:
Do not turn the engine switch Off during this step
because the test results will be lost.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Start the engine.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / O2S B1S2 or
O2S B1S2.
(e) After warming up the engine, run the engine at an engine
speed of 2,500 rpm for 3 minutes.
(f) Read the output voltage of the HO2 sensor when the
engine rpm is suddenly increased.
ES–148
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 3 times using
the accelerator pedal.
Standard:
Fluctuates between 0.4 V or less and 0.5 V or more.
NG
Go to step 13
OK
7
ES
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(a) Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page ES-17).
NEXT
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0136 OR P0156)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 or P0156
A
No output
B
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
9
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Replace the heated oxygen sensor (See page EX-2).
NEXT
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(a) Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page ES-17).
NEXT
11
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0136 OR P0156)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
ES–149
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 or P0156
A
No output
B
B
REPAIR COMPLETED
A
12
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INJECTION VOLUME)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and turn the tester on.
Warm up the engine.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / INJ VOL.
(e) Change the fuel injection volume using the tester,
monitoring the voltage output of Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) and
HO2 sensors displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• Change the fuel injection volume within the range of 12% and +12%. The injection volume can be changed
in 1% graduations within the range.
• The A/F sensor is displayed as AFS B1S1 or AFS
B2S1, and the HO2 sensor is displayed as O2S B1S2
or O2S B2S2, on the intelligent tester.
Result
Tester Display (Sensor)
Voltage Variations
Proceed to
AFS B1S1 (A/F)
AFS B2S1 (A/F)
Alternates between more and less than 3.3 V
OK
AFS B1S1 (A/F)
AFS B2S1 (A/F)
Remains at more than 3.3 V
NG
AFS B1S1 (A/F)
AFS B2S1 (A/F)
Remains at less than 3.3 V
NG
HINT:
A normal HO2 sensor voltage (O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2)
reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in
fuel injection volumes. When the A/F sensor voltage
remains at either less or more than 3.3 V despite the
HO2 sensor indicating a normal reaction, the A/F sensor
is malfunctioning.
ES
ES–150
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Injection Volume
+12%
Malfunction
-12%
A/F Sensor Output
Normal
3.3 V
ES
HO2 Sensor Output
Malfunction
1V
0V
A087979E15
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE EXTREMELY RICH OR LEAN ACTUAL AIR FUEL RATIO (INJECTOR,
FUEL PRESSURE, GAS LEAKAGE FROM EXHAUST SYSTEM,ETC)
13
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
OK:
No gas leakage.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST GAS
LEAKAGE POINT
ES–151
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
14
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
HO2 sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
HO2 Sensor
H6
Bank 1
HT
+B
E1
OX
HO2 Sensor
+B
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
Bank 2
Front View
H8
Bank 2
Tester Connections
HT
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OX
E1
Front View
A126268E05
OK
15
INSPECT EFI RELAY
(a) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the EFI relay resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and
2)
(c) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
B016200
OK
REPLACE EFI RELAY
ES
ES–152
16
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 HO2 sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the HO2
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
HO2 Sensor Connector
H6
Bank 1
HT
+B
1
2
3
4
OX
E1
Front View
ES
H8
Bank 2
HT
2
3
4
OX
Specified Conditions
+B (H6-2) - Body ground
9 V to 14 V
+B (H8-2) - Body ground
9 V to 14 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch off.
(e) Disconnect the E4 and E5 ECM connectors.
(f) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
+B
1
Tester Connections
E1
Tester Connections
ECM:
E5
E4
Specified Conditions
HT (H6-1) - HT1B (E4-1)
Below 1 Ω
OX (H6-3) - OX1B (E4-18)
Below 1 Ω
E1 (H6-4) - E2 (E4-28)
Below 1 Ω
HT (H8-1) - HT2B (E5-5)
Below 1 Ω
OX (H8-3) - OX2B (E5-33)
Below 1 Ω
E1 (H8-4) - E2 (E4-28)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
HT2B
HT1B
OX1B
E2
OX2B
A114613E03
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (H6-1) or HT1B (E4-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
OX (H6-3) or OX1B (E4-18) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E1 (H6-4) or E2 (E4-28) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (H8-1) or HT2B (E5-5) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
OX (H8-3) or OX2B (E5-33) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E1 (H8-4) or E2 (E4-28) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the ECM connectors.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 2):
Engine Room Junction Block
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI No. 2
Fuse
ECM
HO2 Sensor
+B
EFI No. 1 Fuse
HT
HT1B
OX1B
OX1B
Heater
E1
Duty
Control
Sensor
Ground
E2
MREL
G042820E04
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–153
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
ES
ES–154
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0171
System Too Lean (Bank 1)
DTC
P0172
System Too Rich (Bank 1)
DTC
P0174
System Too Lean (Bank 2)
DTC
P0175
System Too Rich (Bank 2)
DESCRIPTION
ES
The fuel trim is related to the feedback compensation value, not to the basic injection time. The fuel trim
consists of both the short-term and long-term fuel trims.
The short-term fuel trim is fuel compensation that is used to constantly maintain the air-fuel ratio at
stoichiometric levels. The signal from the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor indicates whether the air-fuel ratio is
rich or lean compared to the stoichiometric ratio. This triggers a reduction in the fuel injection volume if the
air-fuel ratio is rich and an increase in the fuel injection volume if it is lean.
Factors such as individual engine differences, wear over time and changes in operating environment
cause short-term fuel trim to vary from the central value. The long-term fuel trim, which controls overall
fuel compensation, compensates for long-term deviations in the fuel trim from the central value caused by
the short- term fuel trim compensation.
If both the short-term and long-term fuel trims are lean or rich beyond predetermined values, it is
interpreted as a malfunction, and the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
DTC No.
P0171
P0174
DTC Detection Conditions
With warm engine and stable air-fuel ratio feedback,
fuel trim considerably in error to lean side (2 trip
detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0172
P0175
With warm engine and stable air-fuel ratio feedback,
fuel trim considerably in error to rich side (2 trip
detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air induction system
Injector blockage
Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and A/F sensor heater relay
circuits
PCV valve and hose
PCV hose connections
ECM
Injector leakage or blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and A/F sensor heater relay
circuits
ECM
HINT:
• When DTC P0171 or P0174 is set, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the lean side. When DTC P0172
P0175 is set, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the rich side.
• If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air-fuel ratio is lean and DTC P0171 or P0174 may be set. The MIL is
then illuminated.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–155
• When the total of the short-term and long-term fuel trim values is within the malfunction threshold (and
the engine coolant temperature is more than 75°C [167°F]), the system is functioning normally.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Under closed-loop fuel control, fuel injection volumes that deviate from those estimated by the ECM
cause changes in the long-term fuel trim compensation value. The long-term fuel trim is adjusted when
there are persistent deviations in the short-term fuel trim values. Deviations from the ECM's estimated fuel
injection volumes also affect the average fuel trim learning value, which is a combination of the average
short-term fuel trim (fuel feedback compensation value) and the average long-term fuel trim (learning
value of the air-fuel ratio). If the average fuel trim learning value exceeds the malfunction thresholds, the
ECM interprets this a fault in the fuel system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The average fuel trim learning value is more than +35% or less than -35%, the ECM interprets this as a
fuel system malfunction.
Fuel Compensation Amount
P0171 or P0174:
1.35
+35 (%)
Lean Malfunction Threshold
1.0
P0172 or P0175:
0.65
-35 (%)
Rich Malfunction Threshold
A082386E30
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0171: Fuel system Lean (Bank 1)
P0172: Fuel system Rich (Bank 1)
P0174: Fuel system Lean (Bank 2)
P0175: Fuel system Rich (Bank 2)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Fuel system
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
A/F sensor, Mass air flow meter, Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
ES–156
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
ES
P0010, P0020 (VVT VSV1, 2), P0011, P0012 (VVT System-Advance, Retard),
P0021, P0022(VVT System2-Adavance, Retard), P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F
Sensor heater Sensor 1), P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF Sensor), P0115,
P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor), P0120, P0121, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222,
P0223 , P2135 (TP Sensor), P0125 (Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop), P0335 (CKP
Sensor), P0340 (CMP Sensor), P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354, P0356 (Ignitor),
P0500 (VSS),
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
Either of following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Engine RPM
Below 1,100 rpm
2. Intake air amount per revolution
0.22 g/rev or more
Catalyst monitor
No executed
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Purge-cut
Executing
Either of following conditions met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Average between short-term fuel trim and long-term
fuel trim
35% or more (varies with ECT)
2. Average between short-term fuel trim and long-term
fuel trim
-35% or less (varies with ECT)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-302).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
For use of the intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester on.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. Select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCEDOBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection
volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
ES–157
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
3
4
ES
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air-fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
– Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check the graph of the voltage
outputs of both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
– To display the graph, select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD
II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2. Press the YES button and then the ENTER button. Then press the F4 button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving
condition information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting,
freeze frame data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped,
whether the engine was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as
other data recorded at the time of a malfunction.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a rich air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that
would cause the engine to run rich.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a lean air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that
would cause the engine to run lean.
ES–158
1
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 OR
P0175)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
ES
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175
A
P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175
are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK PCV HOSE CONNECTIONS
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and is not damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
4
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/F CONTROL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and turn the tester on.
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for
approximately 90 seconds.
(d) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
(e) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in
an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT button to
change the fuel injection volume).
ES–159
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(f)
Monitor the voltage outputs of A/F and HO2 sensors
(AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection
volume by 12.5% or increases the injection volume by
25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and
decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
Result
Status AFS
B1S1 or AFS
B2S1
Status O2S
B1S2 or O2S
B2S2
Lean/Rich
Lean/Rich
A/F Condition and A/F
Sensor Condition
Normal
Misfires
Lean
Proceed to
-
C
•
•
•
•
Lean
Suspected Trouble Areas
Actual air-fuel ratio lean
May occur
•
•
•
•
•
•
PCV valve and hose
PCV hose connections
Injector blockage
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Mass Air Flow (MAF)
meter
Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
A
Injector leakage or
blockage
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
A
Rich
Rich
Actual air-fuel ratio rich
-
Lean
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor malfunction
-
A/F sensor
B
Rich
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor malfunction
-
A/F sensor
B
•
•
•
•
Lean: During A/F CONTROL, the A/F sensor output
voltage (AFS) is consistently more than 3.35 V, and the
HO2 sensor output voltage (O2S) is consistently less
than 0.4 V.
Rich: During A/F CONTROL, the AFS is consistently less
than 3.0 V, and the O2S is consistently more than 0.55 V.
Lean/Rich: During A/F CONTROL of the ACTIVE TEST,
the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor
alternates correctly.
B
Go to step 11
C
Go to step 15
ES
ES–160
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COOLANT TEMP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(d) Read the COOLANT TEMP twice, when the engine is
cold and also when warmed up.
Standard:
With cold engine:
Same as ambient air temperature.
With warm engine:
Between 75°C and 95°C (167°F and 203°F)
ES
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MAF)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF and
COOLANT TEMP.
(d) Allow the engine to idle until the COOLANT TEMP
reaches 75°C (167°F) or more.
(e) Read the MAF with the engine in an idling condition and
at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm.
Standard:
MAF while engine idling:
Between 3.2 g/s and 4.7 g/s (shift position: N, A/
C: OFF).
MAF at engine speed of 2,500 rpm:
Between 13.1 g/s and 18.9 g/s (shift position: N,
A/C: OFF).
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
7
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-4).
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–161
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
OK:
No gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST SYSTEM
OK
9
CHECK FOR SPARKS AND IGNITION
(a) Check for sparks and ignition (See page IG-1).
HINT:
If the spark plugs or ignition system malfunctions, engine
misfire may occur. The misfire count can be read using
the intelligent tester. Select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST /
PRIMARY / CYL #1 (to CYL #6).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE IGNITION SYSTEM
OK
10
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY (INJECTION AND VOLUME)
(a) Inspect the fuel injector assembly (See page FU-11).
HINT:
If the injectors malfunction, engine misfire may occur.
The misfire count can be read using the intelligent tester.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / CYL #1
(to CYL #6).
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–162
11
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
A12
Bank 1
ES
+B
HT
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A13
Bank 2
+B
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C
(68°F)
HT (1) - A1A- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C
(68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
Bank 2
HT
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A126269E06
OK
12
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR HEATER RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F sensor heater relay from the engine
room R/B.
(b) Measure the A/F sensor heater relay resistance.
Standard resistance
B016200
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and
2)
(c) Reinstall the A/F sensor heater relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
HEATER RELAY
ES–163
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
13
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side:
A/F Sensor
Connector
A12 Bank 1
HT
+B
AF+
AF-
A13 Bank 2
Front View
HT
+B
AF+
AF-
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (A12-2) - Body
ground
9 to 14 V
+B (A13-2) - Body
ground
9 to 14 V
ECM:
E5
HA1A
A2A+
A2A-
ES
(d) Turn the ignition switch off.
(e) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(f) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
Below 1 Ω
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A138717E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 1):
A/F Sensor
Heater Relay
From
Battery
+B
Heater
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
A/F Heater
Fuse
From EFI
Relay
ECM
A/F Sensor
AF-
Sensor
EFI No. 2
A1A-
Duty
Control
G035624E01
ES–164
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
14
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
15
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
ES
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (Procedure A).
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on
(Procedure B).
(c) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31) (Procedure C).
(d) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the tester (See page ES-35) (Procedure D).
(e) Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories
switched off (Procedure E).
(f) Drive the vehicle at between 38 mph and 75 mph (60
km/h and 120 km/h) and at an engine speed of between
1,400 rpm and 3,200 rpm for 3 to 5 minutes (Procedure
F).
Engine Speed
“F”
Between 1,400 rpm
and 3,200 rpm
Idling
Ignition Switch off
Between 38 mph and
75 mph (60 km/h and
120 km/h)
“E”
2 minutes
3 to 5 minutes
Time
“A”, “B”, “C”, “D”
A079199E68
HINT:
If the system is still malfunctioning, the MIL will be
illuminated during procedure "F".
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed,
no malfunction will be detected.
NEXT
ES–165
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
16
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 OR P0175)
(a) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
(b) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175
B
B
A
END
Go to step 5
ES
ES–166
DTC
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0230
Fuel Pump Primary Circuit
DESCRIPTION
ES
In the diagram below, when the engine is cranked, current flows from terminal ST1 of the ignition switch
into the ECM to the ST (starter) relay coil and also current flows to terminal STA of the ECM (STA signal).
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr1 (power transistor 1) is turned ON, current
flows to the coil of the circuit opening relay, the relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump, and
the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated (engine running), the ECM keeps the Tr1 ON (circuit opening relay ON)
and the fuel pump also keeps operating.
The fuel pump speed is controlled at two levels (high speed or low speed) by engine condition (starting,
light load, heavy load). When the engine starts (STA ON), Tr2 (power transistor 2) in the ECM is OFF, so
the fuel pump relay closes and positive battery voltage is applied directly to the fuel pump. The fuel pump
operates at high speed.
During idling or under light loads, Tr2 goes ON, and then power is supplied to the fuel pump via the fuel
pump resistor. The fuel pump operates at low speed.
ES–167
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM
EFI Relay
EFI
MREL
Fuel Pump Resistor
Circuit Opening Relay
Fuel Pump Relay
FPR
Tr2
FC
Tr1
IGN
Ignition Switch
Fuel Pump
ALT
AM1
AM1
IG1
ST1
STA
AM2
IG2
AM2
ST2
P
N
ST Relay
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
STA
Starter
Crankshaft Position
Sensor (NE Signal)
NE
Battery
A152362E01
DTC No.
P0230
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in fuel pump relay circuit
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in fuel pump relay circuit
Fuel pump relay
ECM
ES
ES–168
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room R/B
EFI Relay
L
2
5
3
2
2
1
W-B
2
IGN
1
5
6
2
3
2
IG2 I18
Ignition
Switch
GR-B
B-W
B-W
2
2
7
R
4
2
2
B J2
AM2
EFI
J/C
1
1
B-R
B J3
B
Engine
Room J/B
W-B
2 IB1
B-R
5
F14
Fuel Pump
EB
Y-B
IC4 5
1
19
Y-B
IM2
F8
Fuel Pump Resistor
Y-B
BO
30
E6
FPR
2
W-B
A J41 A J41
J/C
W-B
Battery
B-Y
B-R
4
2
2
2
B-R
Fuel Engine Room
Pump R/B
Relay
1
5
2
33
10
GR-B E8 FC
IC4
2
3
AM2
Engine Room
C/OPN
R/B
Relay
2
6
2
MREL
23
Driver
B-R Side J/B
2
8
E8
C
2
1D
W-G
B-O
C
1E
35
IC4
W-G
2
J4 J/C
B-O
ES
B
2
A J40
W-B
BL
G032683E02
HINT:
This DTC chart is on the premise that the engine is started normally. If the engine is difficult to start,
proceed to the problem symptoms table (See page ES-21).
ES–169
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine conditions when
malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT ECM (FPR VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
E6
FPR (+)
(a) Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
FPR (E6-30) - E1 (E6-1)
STA signal ON
9 to 14 V
FPR (E6-30) - E1 (E6-1)
STA signal OFF
0 to 3 V
NG
E1 (-)
REPLACE ECM
E118245E32
OK
2
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuel pump relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
A030519E02
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RELAY
ES
ES–170
3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL PUMP RELAY - ECM)
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E6
FPR
ES
Tester Connections
Specified
Conditions
Fuel pump relay (1) - FPR (E6-30)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
Tester Connections
Specified
Conditions
Fuel pump relay (1) or FPR (E6-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room R/B:
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
Fuel Pump Relay
A138718E01
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–171
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0300
Random / Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected
DTC
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0305
Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0306
Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected
ES
DESCRIPTION
When the engine misfires, high concentrations of hydrocarbons (HC) enter the exhaust gas. Extremely
high HC concentration levels can cause increase in exhaust emission levels. High concentrations of HC
can also cause increases in the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) temperature, which may cause
damage to the TWC. To prevent this increase in emissions and to limit the possibility of thermal damage,
the ECM monitors the misfire rate. When the temperature of the TWC reaches the point of thermal
degradation, the ECM blinks the MIL. To monitor misfires, the ECM uses both the Camshaft Position
(CMP) sensor and the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor. The CMP sensor is used to identify any
misfiring cylinders and the CKP sensor is used to measure variations in the crankshaft rotation speed.
Misfires are counted when the crankshaft rotation speed variations exceed predetermined thresholds.
If the misfire exceeds the threshold levels, and could cause emission deterioration, the ECM illuminates
the MIL and sets a DTC.
DTC No.
P0300
DTC Detection Conditions
Simultaneous misfiring of several cylinders are
detected (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in engine wire harness
Connector connections
Vacuum hose connections
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose
PCV hose connection
Air induction system
ECM
ES–172
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
Misfiring of specific cylinder is detected (2 trip detection
logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in engine wire harness
Connector connections
Vacuum hose connections
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose
PCV hose connection
Air induction system
ECM
HINT:
When DTCs for misfiring cylinders are randomly set, but DTC P0300 is not set, it indicates that misfires
have been detected in different cylinders at different times. DTC P0300 is only set when several misfiring
cylinders are detected at the same time.
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope
With the engine idling, check the waveform between terminals #10 to #60 and E01 of the ECM
connectors.
20 V/Division
Items
Contents
Terminals
#10 to #60 - E01
Equipment Settings
20 V/Division, 100 or 1 ms/Division
Conditions
Idling
Injector Signal Waveform
GND
20 V/Division
(Magnification)
GND
100 msec./Division (Idling)
Injection Duration
1 msec./Division (Idling)
A078423E24
ES–173
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Camshaft Position Sensor
Crankshaft Position Sensor
ECM
(36-2 teeth)
ES
A082387E06
The ECM illuminates the MIL (2 trip detection logic) if:
• The percent misfire exceeds the specified limit per 1,000 engine revolutions. One occurrence of
excessive misfire during engine start will set the MIL. Four occurrences are required to set the MIL
1,000 revolutions after engine start.
The ECM blinks the MIL (MIL blinks immediately) if:
• The threshold for percent of misfire causing catalyst damage is reached 1 time within 200 engine
revolutions at a high engine rpm.
• The threshold for percent of misfire causing catalyst damage is reached 3 times within 200 engine
revolutions at a normal engine rpm.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0300: Random/multiple cylinder misfire detected
P0301: Cylinder 1 misfire detected
P0302: Cylinder 2 misfire detected
P0303: Cylinder 3 misfire detected
P0304: Cylinder 4 misfire detected
P0305: Cylinder 5 misfire detected
P0306: Cylinder 6 misfire detected
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Crankshaft position sensor, Camshaft position sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
ECT sensor, IAT sensor, MAF meter
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Every 1,000 revolutions (soon after engine is started: 1 time, other: 4 times)
(emission related misfire)
Every 200 revolutions (1 or 3 times) (catalyst deteriorating misfire)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles: Emission related misfire
MIL flashes immediately: Catalyst damaged misfire
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Misfire:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF Sensor), P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT Sensor),
P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor), P0120, P0121, P0122, P0123, P0220,
P0222, P0223 , P2135 (TP Sensor), P0125 (Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop),
P0327, P0328, P0332, P0333 (Knock Sensor), P0335 (CKP Sensor), P0340 (CMP
Sensor), P0500 (VSS)
Battery voltage
8 V or more
VVT system
No operate by scan tool
Engine RPM
450 to 5,400 rpm
ES–174
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) ECT at engine start
More than -7°C (19°F)
(b) ECT
More than 20°C (68°F)
Fuel cut
OFF
Monitor period of emission-related-misfire:
First 1,000 revolutions after engine start, or check mode
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions
Except above
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions x 4
Monitor period of catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
ES
All of following conditions 1, 2 and 3 are met
Crankshaft 200 revolutions
1. Driving cycle
1st
2. Check mode
OFF
3. Engine RPM
Less than 2,800 rpm
Except above
Crankshaft 200 revolutions x 3
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Monitor period of emission-related-misfire:
Misfire rate
2 % or more
Monitor period of catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
Number of misfire per 200 revolutions
77 or more (varies with intake air amount and RPM)
Paired cylinders misfire
Detected
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to Checking Monitor Status (See page ES-14).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0351 for the wiring diagram of the ignition system (See page ES-200).
ES–175
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM
Driver Side J/B
To Combination Meter
I9 Injector No. 1
6
1D
3
1H
B-R
5
IM1
B-R
B-R 2
B-R
B-R
B-R
6
IG2
I18
Ignition Switch
I10
Injector No. 2
2
B-R
R
2
B-R
AM2
Engine Room R/B
D
J27
J/C
B
3
#20
E6
1
R
4 #30
E6
1
G
5
#40
E6
Y
6
#50
E6
2
L
7
#60
E6
ES
I13
Injector No. 5
B-R 2
1
I14
Injector No. 6
1
2 #10
E6
I12
Injector No. 4
B-R 2
2
1
R-L
I11
Injector No. 3
B-R 2
AM2
7
B-R
D
1 R-L
D
B-R 2
1
B
Battery
G032684E01
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Record the DTC(s) and freeze frame data.
Using the tester, switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode (See page ES-35).
Read the misfire counts of each cylinder (CYL #1 to #6) with the engine in an idling condition. If any
misfire count is displayed, skip the following confirmation driving pattern.
7. Drive the vehicle several times with the conditions, such as engine rpm and engine load, shown in
MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD in the DATA LIST.
HINT:
In order to store misfire DTCs, it is necessary to drive the vehicle for the period of time shown in the
table below, with the MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD in the DATA LIST.
Engine RPM
Duration
Idling
3.5 minutes or more
1,000
3 minutes or more
2,000
1.5 minutes or more
3,000
1 minute or more
ES–176
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8. Check whether misfires have occurred by checking DTCs and freeze frame data.
HINT:
Do not turn the ignition switch off until the stored DTC(s) and freeze frame data have been recorded.
When the ECM returns to normal mode (default), the stored DTC(s), freeze frame data and other data
will be erased.
9. Record the DTC(s), freeze frame data and misfire counts.
10.Turn the ignition switch off and wait for at least 5 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
• If any DTCs other than the misfire DTCs are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
• If the misfire does not recur when the vehicle is brought to the workshop, reproduce the conditions
stored in the freeze frame data.
• If the misfire still cannot be reproduced even though the conditions stored in the freeze frame data
have been duplicated, one of the following factors is considered to be a possible cause of the problem:
1. The fuel tank is low full.
2. Improper fuel is used.
3. The spark plugs have been contaminated.
4. The problem is complex.
• After finishing repairs, check the misfire counts of the cylinders (CYL #1, #2, #3, #4, #5 and #6).
• Be sure to confirm that no misfiring cylinder DTCs are set again by conducting the confirmation driving
pattern, after repairs.
• For 6 and 8 cylinder engines, the ECM intentionally does not set the specific misfiring cylinder DTCs at
high engine RPM. If misfires occur only in high engine RPM areas, only DTC P0300 is set.
If the event of DTC P0300 being present, perform the following operations:
1. Clear the DTC (See page ES-31).
2. Start the engine and conduct the confirmation driving pattern.
3. Read the misfiring rates of each cylinder or DTC(s) using the tester.
4. Repair the cylinder(s) that has a high misfiring rate or is indicated by the DTC.
5. After finishing repairs, conduct the confirmation driving pattern again, in order to verify that DTC
P0300 is not set.
• When one of SHORT FT #1, LONG FT #1, SHORT FT #2 or LONG FT #2 in the freeze frame data is
outside the range of +-20%, the air-fuel ratio may be rich (-20% or less) or lean (+20% or more).
• When the COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 75°C (167°F), the misfires have
occurred only while warming up the engine.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO MISFIRE TO DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305 and/or P0306
A
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305 and/or P0306 and other DTCs
B
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–177
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305 and P0306 are output, troubleshoot those
DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MISFIRE RPM AND MISFIRE LOAD)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / MISFIRE / MISFIRE
RPM and MISFIRE LOAD.
(d) Read and note the MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD
(engine load) values.
HINT:
The MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD indicate the
vehicle conditions under which the misfire occurred.
NEXT
3
CHECK PCV HOSE CONNECTIONS
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and is not damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
4
CHECK MISFIRE COUNT (CYL #1, #2, #3, #4, #5 AND #6)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / MISFIRE / CYL #1,
#2, #3, #4, #5 and #6 (Procedure "A").
(f) Allow the engine to idle.
(g) Read each value of CYL #1 to #6 displayed on the tester
(Procedure "B").
(1) Shift the gear selector lever to the D position.
(2) Repeat procedures "A" to "B" above.
(3) Check the CYL #1 to #6.
(4) If misfire counts are still not displayed, perform
procedures "C" and "D" and then check the misfire
counts again.
(h) Drive the vehicle with the MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE
LOAD noted in step 2 (Procedure "C").
ES
ES–178
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(i)
Read the CYL #1 to #6 or DTCs displayed on the tester
(Procedure "D").
Result
Misfire Count
Proceed to
One or two cylinders have misfire counts
A
Three cylinders or more have misfire counts
B
B
Go to step 13
A
ES
5
CHECK SPARK PLUG
(a) Remove the ignition coil and the spark plug of the
misfiring cylinder.
(b) Measure the spark plug electrode gap.
Standard:
Between 1.0 mm and 1.1 mm (0.039 in. and 0.043
in.)
(c) Check the electrode for carbon deposits.
Require spark plug:
Electrode Gap
Manufacturers
A088861E12
Products
DENSO
K20HR-U11
NGK
LFR6C-11
NOTICE:
If the electrode gap is larger than the standard,
replace the spark plug. Do not adjust the electrode
gap.
NG
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
OK
6
CHECK FOR SPARKS AND IGNITION
(a) Disconnect the injector connectors, in order to prevent
the engine from starting.
(b) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and connect the
ignition coil connector.
(c) Attach the spark plug assembly to the cylinder head
cover.
(d) Crank the engine for less than 2 seconds and check the
spark.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
OK:
Sparks jump across electrode gap
(e) Reconnect the injector connectors.
NG
OK
Go to step 8
ES–179
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Measure the cylinder compression pressure of the
misfiring cylinder (See page EM-2).
OK
Go to step 9
NG
CHECK ENGINE TO DETERMINE CAUSE OF LOW COMPRESSION
ES
8
CHANGE NORMAL SPARK PLUG AND CHECK SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Change the installed spark plug to a spark plug that
functions normally.
(b) Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Always disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if sparks occur while the engine is being
cranked.
OK:
Sparks jump across electrode gap.
OK
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
NG
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
9
INSPECT ECM TERMINAL OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (#10, #20, #30, #40, #50 AND/OR #60
VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E4
and E6 ECM connector.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E4
E01 (-)
#60 (+)
E6
#10 (+)
#50 (+) #30 (+)
#40 (+) #20 (+)
A131509E38
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
#10 (E6-2) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#20 (E6-3) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#30 (E6-4) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#40 (E6-5) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#50 (E6-6) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#60 (E6-7) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
ES–180
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
Go to step 11
NG
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (INJECTOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the injector connector (of the misfiring
cylinder).
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch on.
(d) Measure the resistance and voltage between the injector
and the ECM connector terminals.
Standard (Cylinder No. 1)
Wire Harness Side:
Injector Connector
ES
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
1
2
Tester Connections
Front View
ECM:
E6
I9-1 - Ground
11 to 14 V
I9-2 - Ground
10 kΩ or higher
I9-2 - #10 (E6-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard (Cylinder No. 2)
Tester Connections
#60
#50
#40
Specified Conditions
#10
#20
#30
Specified Conditions
I10-1 - Ground
11 to 14 V
I10-2 - Ground
10 kΩ or higher
I10-2 - #20 (E6-3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard (Cylinder No. 3)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
A114616E03
I11-1 - Ground
11 to 14 V
I11-2 - Ground
10 kΩ or higher
I11-2 - #30 (E6-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard (Cylinder No. 4)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
I12-1 - Ground
11 to 14 V
I12-2 - Ground
10 kΩ or higher
I12-2 - #40 (E6-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard (Cylinder No. 5)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
I13-1 - Ground
11 to 14 V
I13-2 - Ground
10 kΩ or higher
I13-2 - #50 (E6-6)
Below 1 Ω
Standard (Cylinder No. 6)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
I13-1 - Ground
11 to 14 V
I13-2 - Ground
10 kΩ or higher
I13-2 - #60 (E6-7)
Below 1 Ω
(e) Reconnect the injector connector.
(f) Reconnect the ECM connector.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–181
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
11
CHECK FUEL INJECTOR OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Check the injector injection (whether fuel volume is high
or low, and whether injection pattern is poor) (See page
IG-1).
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
ES
OK
12
CHECK VALVE CLEARANCE (MISFIRING CYLINDER)
NG
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
OK
13
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
14
CHECK VALVE TIMING
(a) Remove the cylinder head cover (See page EM-130).
(b) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with the
timing mark "0" of the timing chain cover.
(c) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing gears
are aligned with the timing marks of the bearing cap as
shown in the illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°), then align
the marks as above.
OK:
Point marks on camshaft timing gears are aligned
as shown in the illustration.
(d) Reinstall the cylinder head cover (See page EM-195).
NG
OK
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
ES–182
15
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-4).
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE FUEL PUMP,
PRESSURE REGULATOR, FUEL PIPE LINE
AND FILTER
OK
ES
16
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COOLANT TEMP)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
COOLANT TEMP.
(e) Read the COOLANT TEMP twice, when the engine is
cold and also when warmed up.
Standard:
With cold engine:
Same as ambient air temperature.
With warm engine:
Between 75°C and 95°C (167°F and 203°F).
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
17
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MAF)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF and
COOLANT TEMP.
(e) Allow the engine to idle until the COOLANT TEMP
reaches 75°C (167°F) or more.
(f) Read the MAF with the engine in an idling condition and
at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm.
Standard:
MAF while engine idling:
Between 3.2 g/s and 4.7 g/s (shift position: N, A/
C: OFF).
MAF at engine speed of 2,500 rpm:
Between 13.1 g/s and 18.9 g/s (shift position: N,
A/C: OFF).
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–183
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–17
CHECKING MONITOR STATUS
The purpose of the monitor result (mode 06) is to allow
access to the results for on-board diagnostic monitoring tests
of specific components/systems that are not continuously
monitored. Examples are catalyst, evaporative emission
(EVAP) and thermostat.
The monitor result allows the OBD II scan tool to display the
monitor status, test value, minimum test limit and maximum
test limit. These data are displayed after the vehicle has been
driven to run the monitor.
When the test value is not between the minimum test limit
and maximum test limit, the ECM (PCM) interprets this as a
malfunction. When the component is not malfunctioning, if the
difference of the test value and test limit is very small, the
component will malfunction in the near future.
Perform the following instruction to view the monitor status.
Although this instruction reference the Lexus/Toyota
diagnostic tester, it can be checked using a generic OBD II
scan tool. Refer to your scan tool operator's manual for
specific procedures.
1. PERFORM MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and the tester ON.
(c) Clear DTCs (See page ES-17).
(d) Run the vehicle in accordance with the applicable
drive pattern described in READINESS MONITOR
DRIVE PATTERN (See page ES-31). Do not turn
the ignition switch OFF.
NOTICE:
The test results will be lost if the ignition switch
is turned OFF.
2. ACCESS MONITOR RESULT
(a) Select from the intelligent tester menus:
DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD II, MONITOR INFO
and MONITOR RESULT. The monitor status
appears after the component name.
• INCMP: The component has not been monitored
yet.
• PASS: The component is functioning normally.
• FAIL: The component is malfunctioning.
(b) Confirm that the component is either PASS or FAIL.
(c) Select the component and press ENTER. The
accuracy test value appears if the monitor status is
either PASS or FAIL.
3. CHECK COMPONENT STATUS
(a) Compare the test value with the minimum test limit
(MIN LIMIT) and maximum test limit (MAX LIMIT).
ES
ES–18
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES
4.
(b) If the test value is between the minimum test limit
and maximum test limit, the component is
functioning normally. If not, the component is
malfunctioning. The test value is usually significantly
higher or lower than the test limit. If the test value is
on the borderline of the test limit, the component will
malfunction in the near future.
HINT:
The monitor result might on rare occasions be
PASS even if the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
illuminated. This indicates the system malfunctioned
on a previous driving cycle. This might be caused by
an intermittent problem.
MONITOR RESULT INFORMATION
If you use a generic scan tool, multiply the value by the
scaling value listed below.
A/F Sensor Bank 1 Sensor 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$01
$8E
Multiply by 0.001
V
$01
$91
Multiply by 0.004
mA
Description
A/F sensor deterioration level
A/F sensor current
A/F Sensor Bank 2 Sensor 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$05
$8E
Multiply by 0.001
V
$05
$91
Multiply by 0.004
mA
Description
A/F sensor deterioration level
A/F sensor current
HO2 Sensor Bank 1 Sensor 2
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$02
$07
Multiply by 0.001
V
Description
Minimum sensor voltage
$02
$08
Multiply by 0.001
V
Maximum sensor voltage
$02
$8F
Multiply by 0.0003
g
Maximum oxygen storage capacity
HO2 Sensor Bank 2 Sensor 2
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$06
$07
Multiply by 0.001
V
Description
Minimum sensor voltage
$06
$08
Multiply by 0.001
V
Maximum sensor voltage
$06
$8F
Multiply by 0.0003
g
Maximum oxygen storage capacity
Catalyst - Bank 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$21
$A9
Multiply by 0.0003
No dimension
Description
Oxygen storage capacity of catalyst - Bank 1
Catalyst - Bank 2
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$22
$A9
Multiply by 0.0003
No dimension
Description
Oxygen storage capacity of catalyst - Bank 2
EVAP
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$3D
$C9
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Description
$3D
$CA
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for gross leak (P0455)
$3D
$CB
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for leak detection pump OFF stuck (P2401)
$3D
$CD
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for leak detection pump ON stuck (P2402)
$3D
$CE
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for vent valve OFF stuck (P2420)
Test value for small leak (P0456)
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$3D
$CF
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
ES–19
Description
Test value for vent valve ON stuck (P2419)
$3D
$D0
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for reference orifice low flow (P043E)
$3D
$D1
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for reference orifice high flow (P043F)
$3D
$D4
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge VSV close stuck (P0441)
$3D
$D5
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge VSV open stuck (P0441)
$3D
$D7
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge flow insufficient (P0441)
Rear Oxygen Sensor Heater
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
$42
$91
Multiply by 0.001
Ohm
Oxygen sensor heater resistance bank 1 sensor 2
Description
$46
$91
Multiply by 0.001
Ohm
Oxygen sensor heater resistance bank 2 sensor 2
ES
Misfire
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$A1
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
Exponential Weighted Moving Average (EWMA) misfire for
all cylinders:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A1
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for all cylinders:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
$A2
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder 1:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A2
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 1:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
$A3
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder 2:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A3
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 2:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
$A4
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder 3:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A4
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 3:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
$A5
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder 4:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A5
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 4:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
$A6
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder 5:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A6
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 5:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
$A7
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder 6:
Misfire counts for last 10 driving cycles - Total
$A7
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 6:
Misfire counts for last/current driving cycles - Total
ES–184
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0327
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
DTC
P0328
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
DTC
P0332
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit Low Input (Bank 2)
DTC
P0333
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit High Input (Bank 2)
DESCRIPTION
A flat type knock sensor (non-resonant type) has a structure that can detect vibrations over a wide band of
frequencies: between approximately 6 kHz and 15 kHz.
Knock sensors are fitted onto the engine block to detect engine knocking.
The knock sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes deformed.
The voltage is generated when the engine block vibrates due to knocking. Any occurrence of engine
knocking can be suppressed by delaying the ignition timing.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P0327
P0332
Output voltage of knock sensor 1 or 2 is less than 0.5 V
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Short in knock sensor 1 or 2 circuit
Knock sensor 1 or 2
ECM
P0328
P0333
Output voltage of knock sensor 1 or 2 is more than 4.5
V (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open in knock sensor 1 or 2 circuit
Knock sensor 1 or 2
ECM
HINT:
When any of DTCs P0327, P0328, P0332 and P0333 are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During failsafe mode, the ignition timing is delayed to its maximum retardation. Fail-safe mode continues until the
ignition switch is turned off.
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope
KNK1 Signal Waveform
1 V/DIV
GND
1 msec./Division
A085286E31
The correct waveform is as shown.
Items
Contents
Terminals
KNK1 - EKNK or KNK2 - EKN2
Equipment Settings
0.01 to 10 V/Division, 0.01 to 10 msec./
Division
Conditions
Keep engine speed at 4,000 rpm with
warm engine
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–185
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The knock sensor, located on the cylinder block, detects spark knock. When spark knock occurs, the
piezoelectric element of the sensor vibrates. When the ECM detects the voltage in this frequency range, it
retards the ignition timing to suppress the spark knock.
The ECM also senses background engine noise with the knock sensor and uses this noise to check for
faults in the sensor. If the knock sensor signal level is too low for more than 10 seconds, and if the knock
sensor output voltage is out of the normal range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the knock sensor
and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0327: Knock sensor (Bank 1) range check (Low voltage)
P0328: Knock sensor (Bank 1) range check (High voltage)
P0332: Knock sensor (Bank 2) range check (Low voltage)
P0333: Knock sensor (Bank 2) range check (High voltage)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Knock sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
5 seconds or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Knock Sensor Range Check (Low voltage) P0327 and P0332:
Knock sensor voltage
Less than 0.5 V
Knock Sensor Range Check (High voltage) P0328 and P0333:
Knock sensor voltage
More than 4.5 V
ES
ES–186
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
K1
Knock Sensor
(Bank 1)
ECM
5V
ES
B
1
2
(*1)
W
K2
Knock Sensor
(Bank 2)
(*1)
(*1)
BR
2
ED1
B
5
ED1
W
1
ED1
(*1)
BR
(*1)
28
EKNK
E5
(*1)
5V
(*1)
(*1)
G
1
29
KNK1
E5
2
(*1)
R
4
ED1
G
6
ED1
R
21
KNK2
E5
(*1)
20
EKN2
E5
BR
EE
*1: Shielded
A130684E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• DTCs P0327 and P0328 are for the bank 1 knock sensor circuit.
• DTCs P0332 and P0333 are for the bank 2 knock sensor circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–187
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
READ VALUE OF DTC OUTPUT (CHECK KNOCK SENSOR CIRCUIT)
ED1
Knock Sensor
2
2
1
2
(a) Disconnect the ED1 connector.
(b) Using lead wires, connect the connectors as follows.
Male Connector - Female Connector
2
1
ECM
5
5
4
4
6
6
Male
Connector
29
E5
28
E5
21
E5
20
E5
Terminal 2 - Terminal 4
KNK1
Terminal 5 - Terminal 6
EKNK
Terminal 4 - Terminal 2
Terminal 6 - Terminal 5
KNK2
EKN2
Female
Connector
ED1
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Warm up the engine.
Run the engine at 3,000 rpm for 10 seconds or more.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the intelligent tester
on.
(g) Select the item: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(h) Read DTCs.
Result
Display
Proceed to
DTCs same as when vehicle brought in
P0327, P0328 → P0327, P0328 or P0332,
P0333 → P0332, P0333
A
DTCs different from when vehicle brought in
P0327, P0328 → P0332, P0333 or P0332,
P0333 → P0327, P0328
B
A073822E15
(i)
B
A
Reconnect the ED1 connector.
Go to step 4
ES
ES–188
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (CONNECTOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the ED1 connector.
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Female Connector
ED1
Front View
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
ED1 female connector 2 - KNK1 (E5-29)
Below 1 Ω
ED1 female connector 5 - EKNK (E5-28)
Below 1 Ω
ED1 female connector 4 - KNK2 (E5-21)
Below 1 Ω
ED1 female connector 6 - EKN2 (E5-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E5
EKN2
KNK2
KNK1
EKNK
ECM Connector
A138719E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
ED1 female connector 2 or KNK1 (E5-29) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ED1 female connector 5 or EKNK (E5-28) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ED1 female connector 4 or KNK2 (E5-21) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ED1 female connector 6 or EKN2 (E5-20) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ED1 connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT ECM
ECM:
KNK1
KNK2
(a) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the ECM terminals.
Standard voltage
EKN2
EKNK
E5
G035655E06
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
KNK1 (E5-29) - EKNK (E5-28)
4.5 to 5.5 V
KNK2 (E5-21) - EKN2 (E5-20)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NOTICE:
Fault may be intermittent. Check the wire harness
and connectors carefully and retest.
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–189
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Check the knock sensor installation.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
ES
A076270
OK
5
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ED1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
ED1 male connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
Male Connector
ED1
Front View
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
ED1 male connector 2 - 5
120 to 280 kΩ
ED1 male connector 4 - 6
120 to 280 kΩ
(c) Reconnect the connector.
A072922E17
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CONNECTOR - KNOCK SENSOR)
HINT:
• If DTC P0327 or P0328 has changed to P0332 or P0333,
check the knock sensor circuit on the right bank side.
• If DTC P0332 or P0333 has changed to P0327 or P0328,
check the knock sensor circuit on the left bank side.
ES–190
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a) Disconnect the ED1 connector.
(b) Disconnect the K1 and K2 knock sensor connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Male Connector
ED1
Front View
Wire Harness Side:
K1
Bank 1
K2
Bank 2
A138720E01
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
ED1 male connector 2 - K1-2
Below 1 Ω
ED1 male connector 5 - K1-1
Below 1 Ω
ED1 male connector 4 - K2-2
Below 1 Ω
ED1 male connector 6 - K2-1
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
ED1 male connector 2 or K1-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ED1 male connector 5 or K1-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ED1 male connector 4 or K2-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ED1 male connector 6 or K2-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the connector.
(e) Reconnect the knock sensor connector.
Front View
OK
Specified Conditions
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Knock Sensor Connector
ES
Tester Connections
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–191
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit
DTC
P0339
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Intermittent
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor system consists of a CKP sensor plate and a pickup coil. The
sensor plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft. The pickup coil is made of an iron core and a
magnet.
The sensor plate rotates and as each tooth passes through the pickup coil, a pulse signal is created. The
pickup coil generates 34 signals per engine revolution. Based on these signals, the ECM calculates the
crankshaft position and engine RPM. Using these calculations, the fuel injection time and ignition timing
are controlled.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P0335
•
•
•
•
Open or short in CKP sensor circuit
CKP sensor
Sensor plate (CKP sensor plate)
ECM
Under conditions (a), (b) and (c), no CKP sensor signal
to ECM for 0.05 seconds or more (1 trip detection
logic):
(a) Engine speed 1,000 rpm or more
(b) Starter signal OFF
(c) 3 seconds or more has lapsed since starter signal
switched from ON to OFF
•
•
•
•
Open or short in CKP sensor circuit
CKP sensor
Sensor plate (CKP sensor plate)
ECM
•
P0339
Trouble Areas
No CKP sensor signal to ECM while cranking (1 trip
detection logic)
No CKP sensor signal to ECM at engine speed of
600 rpm or more (1 trip detection logic)
•
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
NE
5 V/DIV
GND
VV1
GND
VV2
GND
G035795E19
HINT:
• The correct waveform is shown on the illustration.
• VV1+ and VV2+ stands for the VVT sensor signal, and NE+ stands for the CKP sensor signal.
Items
Contents
Terminals
VV1+ - VV1VV2+ - VV2NE+ - NE-
Equipment Settings
5 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Conditions
Cranking or idling
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the CKP sensor despite the engine revolving, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction of the sensor.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 10 seconds after the engine is next started.
ES
ES–192
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0335: Crankshaft position sensor range check or rationality
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Crankshaft Position sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
VVT sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Conditions met for 3 times
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
ES
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Case 1:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Time after starter ON to OFF
3 seconds or more
Case 2:
Time after starter ON to OFF
0.3 seconds or more
Number of camshaft position sensor signal pulse
6 times
Ignition switch
ON
Battery voltage
7 V or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1:
Engine speed signal
No signal
Case 2:
Number of crankshaft position sensor signal pulse
132 or less, or 174 or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Crankshaft Position Sensor
•
•
Crankshaft position sensor output voltage fluctuates while crankshaft revolving
34 crankshaft position sensor signals per crankshaft revolution
ES–193
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
V4
VVT Sensor RH
ECM
1
R
2
G
3
L-R
3
L-R
L-R
19
E6 VV1+
29
E6 VV123
E4 VC
V3
VVT Sensor LH
ES
1
Y
2
L
C4
Crankshaft Position Sensor
18
E6 VV2+
28
E6 VV2-
Shielded
1
B
2
W
21
NE+
E6
20
NEE6
BR
EE
G039648E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If no problem is found by this diagnostic troubleshooting procedure, troubleshoot the engine
mechanical systems.
• Check the engine speed. The engine speed can be checked by using the intelligent tester. To check,
follow the operation below:
(a)Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b)Start the engine.
(c) Turn the tester on.
(d)Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
ENGINE SPD.
The engine speed may be indicated as zero despite the engine revolving normally. This is caused
by a lack of NE signals from the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor. Alternatively, the engine speed
may be indicated as lower than the actual engine speed, if the CKP sensor voltage output is
insufficient.
ES–194
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the C4 Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
Standard resistance
Component Side:
Crankshaft Position Sensor
ES
C4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
1-2
1,630 Ω to 2,740 Ω at cold
1-2
2,065 Ω to 3,225 Ω at hot
Front View
A078431E20
HINT:
Terms cold and hot refer to the temperature of the coils.
Cold means approximately -10° to 50°C (14° to 122°F).
Hot means approximately 50° to 100°C (122° to 212°F).
(c) Reconnect the CKP sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side:
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the C4 CKP sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
C4
1
2
NE+
NE-
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
NE+ (C4-1) - NE+ (E6-21)
Below 1 Ω
NE- (C4-2) - NE- (E6-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Front View
ECM:
E6
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
NE+ (C4-1) or NE+ (E6-21) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NE- (C4-2) or NE- (E6-20) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the CKP sensor connector.
NG
NE+
NEA114619E03
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
ES–195
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Check the CKP sensor installation.
OK:
Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
Clearance
Normal
Abnormal
ES
BR03795E54
OK
4
CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE (TEETH OF SENSOR PLATE)
(a) Check the teeth of the sensor plate.
OK:
Sensor plate does not have any cracks or
deformation.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR PLATE
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
Intelligent Tester
ES–401
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
G039021E01
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(2) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(3) Start the engine and warm it up.
(4) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT
CTRL B1.
(5) Operate the OCV using the intelligent tester,
then check the engine speed.
Standard
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV ON
Rough idling or engine stalls
If the operation is not as specified, check the
camshaft timing oil control valve, wire harness
and ECM.
INSPECTION
1.
Ohmmeter
A095415E01
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (+B) - 2 (GND)
6.9 to 7.9 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
camshaft timing oil control valve.
Valve
Battery
A076909E04
(b) Check the operation.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 2,
and check that the valve operates.
NOTICE:
Check that the spool valve is not stuck.
HINT:
The spool valve may not return if foreign
objects are caught in it. This may cause subtle
pressure leakage to the advance side, and a
DTC may, be set.
ES
ES–196
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit (Bank 1
or Single Sensor)
DTC
P0342
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Low
Input (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
DTC
P0343
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit High
Input (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
DTC
P0345
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit (Bank 2)
DTC
P0347
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Low
Input (Bank 2)
DTC
P0348
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit High
Input (Bank 2)
DESCRIPTION
The variable valve timing (VVT) sensor (VV signal) consists of a magnet, iron core and pickup coil.
The VV signal plate has 3 teeth on its outer circumference and is installed on the camshaft timing pulley.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating a voltage in the pickup coil.
This sensor monitors a timing rotor located on the camshaft and is used to detect a camshaft angle by the
ECM. The camshaft rotation synchronizes with the crankshaft rotation, and this sensor communicates the
rotation of the camshaft timing rotor as a pulse signal to the ECM. Based on the signal, the ECM controls
fuel injection time and ignition timing.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
•
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Jumped tooth of timing chain
ECM
Output voltage of VVT sensor is 0.3 V or less for 5
seconds (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Jumped tooth of timing chain
ECM
Output voltage of VVT sensor is 4.7 V or more for 5
seconds (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Jumped tooth of timing chain
ECM
•
P0343
P0348
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
P0340
P0345
P0342
P0347
Input voltage to ECM remains 0.3 V or less, or 4.7
V or higher for more than 5 seconds, when 2 or
more seconds have elapsed after turning the
ignition switch ON (2 trip detection logic)
No VVT sensor signal to ECM during cranking (1
trip detection logic)
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
ES–197
5 V/DIV.
NE
GND
VV1
GND
VV2
GND
20 ms/DIV.
G035795E20
HINT:
• The correct waveform is shown on the illustration.
• VV1+ and VV2+ stands for the VVT sensor signal, and NE+ stands for the CKP sensor signal.
Items
Contents
Terminals
NE+ - NEVV1+ - VV1VV2+ - VV2-
Equipment Settings
5V/Division, 20ms/Division
Conditions
Cranking or idling
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the VVT sensor even though the engine is turning, or if the rotation of the
camshaft and crankshaft is not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0340: Camshaft position sensor range check
P0340: Camshaft position/crankshaft position misalignment
P0340: Camshaft position sensor range check (Chattering)
P0342: Camshaft position sensor range check (Low voltage)
P0343: Camshaft position sensor range check (High voltage)
P0345: VVT sensor range check (While starting engine)
P0345: VVT sensor range check (After starting engine)
P0345: VVT sensor range check (Chattering)
P0347: VVT sensor range check (Low voltage)
P0348: VVT sensor range check (High voltage)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
VVT sensor, Camshaft position sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
4 seconds:
P0340 (Camshaft position sensor range check), P0345 (VVT sensor range check
(While starting engine))
5 seconds:
Others
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles:
P0340 (Camshaft position sensor range check), P0345 (VVT sensor range check
(While starting engine))
Immediate:
Others
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
ES
ES–198
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Camshaft Position Sensor Range Check:
Starter
ON and not starter ON again
Minimal battery voltage while starter ON
Less than 11 V
Camshaft Position/Crankshaft Position Misalignment:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Camshaft Position Sensor Range Check (Chattering, Low voltage, High voltage):
ES
Starter
OFF
Ignition switch ON and time after ignition switch is OFF
to ON
2 seconds or more
VVT sensor range check (While starting engine):
Starter
ON
Battery voltage while starter ON once at least
Less than 11 V
VVT sensor range check (After starting engine):
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
VVT sensor range check (Chattering, Low voltage, High voltage):
Starter
OFF
Ignition switch ON and time after ignition switch is OFF
to ON
2 seconds or more
Battery voltage
8 V or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Camshaft Position Sensor Range Check:
Camshaft position sensor signal
No signal
Camshaft Position/Crankshaft Position Misalignment:
Camshaft position and crankshaft position phase
Mis-aligned
Camshaft Position Sensor Range Check (Chattering):
Camshaft position sensor voltage
Less than 0.3 V, or more than 4.7 V
Camshaft Position Sensor Range Check (Low voltage):
Camshaft position sensor voltage
Less than 0.3 V
Camshaft Position Sensor Range Check (High voltage):
Camshaft position sensor voltage
More than 4.7 V
VVT sensor range check (While starting engine):
VVT sensor signal
No signal
VVT sensor range check (After starting engine):
VVT sensor signal
No signal
VVT sensor range check (Chattering):
VVT sensor voltage
Less than 0.3 V, or more than 4.7 V
VVT sensor range check (Low voltage):
VVT sensor voltage
Less than 0.3 V
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–199
VVT sensor range check (High voltage):
VVT sensor voltage
More than 4.7 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VVT sensor voltage
0.3 to 4.7 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (See page ES-187).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ECM TERMINAL VOLTAGE
(a) Inspect the ECM using an oscilloscope.
(1) While the engine is idling, check the waveform of
the ECM connector.
OK
ECM:
NE+ NE-
E6
VV1+ VV2+
VV1- VV2-
GND
VV1
GND
VV2
GND
20 ms/DIV.
NG
Specified Conditions
VV1+ (E6-19) - VV1- (E6-29)
Correct waveform shown
VV2+ (E6-18) - VV2- (E6-28)
Correct waveform shown
NE+ (E6-21) - NE- (E6-20)
Correct waveform shown
OK
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
NE
Tester Connections
A114620E05
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–200
2
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VVT SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V3 or V4 VVT sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
V4
Bank 1
V3
Bank 2
1 2 3
VVT Sensor
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VVT sensor (V4-1) - VV1+ (E6-19)
Below 1 Ω
VVT sensor (V3-1) - VV2+ (E6-18)
Below 1 Ω
VVT sensor (V3 or V4-3) - NE- (E6-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM:
E6
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VVT sensor (V4-1) or VV1+ (E6-19) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VVT sensor (V3-1) or VV2+ (E6-18) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VVT sensor (V3 or V4-3) or NE- (E6-20) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the VVT sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
VV2+
NE-
VV1+
NG
A114621E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK VVT SENSOR (SENSOR POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the V3 or V4 VVT sensor connector.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the VVT
sensor.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
V4
Bank 1
V3
Bank 2
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3 - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
(c) Reconnect the VVT sensor connector.
VVT Sensor
G038815E05
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ECM
OK
4
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (VVT SENSOR)
(a) Check the VVT sensor installation.
OK:
Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE VVT SENSOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5
ES–201
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSEMBLY (TEETH OF PLATE)
(a) Check the teeth of the signal plate.
OK:
Sensor plate teeth do not have any cracks or
deformation.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–202
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0351
Ignition Coil "A" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0352
Ignition Coil "B" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0353
Ignition Coil "C" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0354
Ignition Coil "D" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0355
Ignition Coil "E" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0356
Ignition Coil "F" Primary / Secondary Circuit
HINT:
• These DTCs indicate malfunctions relating to the primary circuit.
• If DTC P0351 is set, check No. 1 ignition coil with igniter circuit.
• If DTC P0352 is set, check No. 2 ignition coil with igniter circuit.
• If DTC P0353 is set, check No. 3 ignition coil with igniter circuit.
• If DTC P0354 is set, check No. 4 ignition coil with igniter circuit.
• If DTC P0355 is set, check No. 5 ignition coil with igniter circuit.
• If DTC P0356 is set, check No. 6 ignition coil with igniter circuit.
DESCRIPTION
A Direct Ignition System (DIS) is used on this vehicle.
The DIS is a 1-cylinder ignition system in which each cylinder is ignited by one ignition coil and one spark
plug is connected to the end of each secondary wiring. A powerful voltage, generated in the secondary
wiring, is applied directly to each spark plug. The sparks of the spark plugs pass from the center
electrodes to the ground electrodes.
The ECM determines the ignition timing and transmits the ignition (IGT) signals to each cylinder. Using the
IGT signal, the ECM turns the power transistor inside the igniter on and off. The power transistor, in turn,
switches on and off the current to the primary coil. When the current to the primary coil is cut off, a
powerful voltage is generated in the secondary coil. This voltage is applied to the spark plugs, causing
them to spark inside the cylinders. As the ECM cuts the current to the primary coil, the igniter sends back
an ignition confirmation (IGF) signal to the ECM, for each cylinder ignition.
ES–203
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
From Battery
ECM
Igniter
No. 1 Ignition Coil with Igniter
IGT1
No. 1 Cylinder
IGF1
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
VVT
Sensor
Ignition Coil
IGT2
No. 2 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
IGT3
No. 3 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
IGT4
No. 4 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
IGT5
No. 5 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
IGT6
No. 6 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
Spark Plug
No. 2 Cylinder
ES
No. 3 Cylinder
No. 4 Cylinder
Other Sensor
(Engine Coolant Temperature.
Sensor, Mass Air Flow Meter,
Throttle Position Sensor, etc.)
No. 5 Cylinder
No. 6 Cylinder
TACH
To Tachometer
A082677E06
DTC No.
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
P0355
P0356
DTC Detection Conditions
No IGF signal to ECM while engine running (1 trip
detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT circuit (1 to 6)
between ignition coil with igniter and ECM
No. 1 to No. 6 ignition coils with igniters
ECM
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope
IGT and IGF Signal Waveform 2 V/Division
CH1
GND
CH2
GND
20 msec./Division
G042403E01
ES–204
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
While cranking or idling, check the waveform between terminals IGT (1 to 6) and E1, and IGF1 and E1 of
the ECM connector.
Items
Contents
Terminals
CH1: IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5,
IGT6 - E1
CH2: IGF1 - E1
Equipment Settings
2 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Conditions
Cranking or idling
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Coil with Igniter
ES
IGT
ECM
Ignition Coil
Igniter
IGF
Ignition Signal (IGT)
Normal
Ignition
Confirmation
Signal (IGF) Malfunction
Circuit Open
Time
A082388E23
If the EMC does not receive the ignition confirmation (IGF) signal after sending the ignition (IGT) signal, it
interprets as a fault in the igniter and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0351: No.1 ignition coil with igniter circuit malfunction
P0352: No.2 ignition coil with igniter circuit malfunction
P0353: No.3 ignition coil with igniter circuit malfunction
P0354: No.4 ignition coil with igniter circuit malfunction
P0355: No.5 ignition coil with igniter circuit malfunction
P0356: No.6 ignition coil with igniter circuit malfunction
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Igniter
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.256 seconds +4 sparks
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–205
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Engine speed
1,500 rpm or less
Spark cut
Not operating
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Following conditions are met:
Condition (a) and (b)
(a) Engine RPM
500 rpm or less
(b) Battery voltage
6 V or more
2. Following conditions are met:
Condition (c), (d) and (e)
(c) Engine RPM
More than 500 rpm
(d) Battery voltage
10 V or more
(e) Number of sparks after CPU is reset
5 sparks or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Ignition signal fail count
More than 2
Ignition signal fail count is on the right:
When IGF does not return despite sending IGT.
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
IGF signal
Igniter outputs IGF signal when it receives IGT signal from ECM
ES
ES–206
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
I1 Ignition Coil Assembly
(with Igniter No. 1)
13
IM1
B-R
B-R
B-R
B-R
B-R
ES
1H 4
4
2
W-B
W-R
B-R
B-R
W-B
1
3
4
2
7
R
W-B
1
3
4
2
Engine
Room
R/B
2
W-B
1
3
4
2
IGT3
W-R
IGT4
I5 Ignition Coil Assembly
(with Igniter No. 5)
GR
1
1
3
4
2
W-B
B-R
W-B
W-B
W-R
12
E4
IGT5
W-R
I6 Ignition Coil Assembly
(with Igniter No. 6)
L
B
W-B
11
E4
W-R
B-R
2
10
E4
LG-B
B-R
AM2
W-R
I4 Ignition Coil Assembly
(with Igniter No. 4)
W-B
2
IGT2
W-R
B-R
1
9
E4
LG
B-R
2
N1
Noise
Filter
W-R
I3 Ignition Coil Assembly
(with Igniter No. 3)
W-B
AM2
IGT1
24
IGF1
E4
W-R
B-R
I18
Ignition
Switch
W-R
P-L
W-B
B-R
IG2
3
B-R
1D 6
6
1
I2 Ignition Coil Assembly
(with Igniter No. 2)
Driver
Side J/B
8
E4
Y-R
1
3
4
2
W-B
13
E4
IGT6
W-R
Battery
EF
G032686E02
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–207
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354, P0355 OR
P0356)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Shuffle arrangement of the ignition coils with igniters
(among No. 1 to No. 6 cylinders).
NOTICE:
Do not shuffle the connectors.
(f) Perform a simulation test.
(g) Check DTCs displayed on the tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354, P0355 or P0356
A
Any other DTCs
B
B
A
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–208
2
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM (IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5 IGT6 AND IGF1 SIGNAL)
(a) Inspect the ECM using an oscilloscope.
(b) While cranking or idling, check the waveform between
the terminals of the E4 and E6 ECM connector.
Standard
IGT2 (+) IGT1 (+)
E4
ES
E1 (-)
E6
IGF1 (+) IGT5 (+)
IGT3 (+)
IGT4 (+) ECM Connector
IGT6 (+)
IGT and IGF Signal Waveform
2 V/
Division
20 msec./Division
NG
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
IGT1 (E4-8) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
IGT2 (E4-9) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
IGT3 (E4-10) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
IGT4 (E4-11) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
IGT5 (E4-12) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
IGT6 (E4-13) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
IGF1 (E4-24) - E1 (E6-1)
Correct waveform
shown
REPLACE ECM
A138721E01
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5 or I6 ignition coil with
igniter connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
ECM:
E4
IGT5
IGT3
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
IGF (I1-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGT1
IGT2
IGT4
IGT6
IGF (I2-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I3-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I4-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I5-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
Wire Harness Side:
IGF (I6-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF1
Ignition Coil with Igniter Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
1
2
3
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
IGT (I1-3) - IGT1 (E4-8)
Below 1 Ω
4
IGF IGT
Front View
A114622E05
IGT (I2-3) - IGT2 (E4-9)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I3-3) - IGT3 (E4-10)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I4-3) - IGT4 (E4-11)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I5-3) - IGT5 (E4-12)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I6-3) - IGT6 (E4-13)
Below 1 Ω
ES–209
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
IGF (I1-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I2-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I3-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I4-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I5-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I6-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
IGT (I1-3) or IGT1 (E4-8) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I2-3) or IGT2 (E4-9) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I3-3) or IGT3 (E4-10) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I4-3) or IGT4 (E4-11) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I5-3) or IGT5 (E4-12) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I6-3) or IGT6 (E4-13) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
INSPECT IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5 or I6 ignition coil with
igniter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Ignition Coil with Igniter Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
+B (+) GND (-)
Front View
A054393E73
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
GND (I1-4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND (I2-4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND (I3-4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND (I4-4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND (I5-4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND (I6-4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Turn the ignition switch on.
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the wire
harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (I1-1) - GND (I1-4)
9 to 14 V
+B (I2-1) - GND (I2-4)
9 to 14 V
+B (I3-1) - GND (I3-4)
9 to 14 V
+B (I4-1) - GND (I4-4)
9 to 14 V
+B (I5-1) - GND (I5-4)
9 to 14 V
+B (I6-1) - GND (I6-4)
9 to 14 V
(e) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connector.
ES
ES–210
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY - IGNITION SWITCH)
Wire Harness Side:
ES
Ignition Coil with Igniter Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
1
2
3
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5 or I6 ignition coil with
igniter connector.
(b) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
4
I6
+B
Front View
Ignition Switch Connector
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (I1-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
+B (I2-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
+B (I3-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
+B (I4-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
+B (I5-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
+B (I6-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
I18
IG2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Front View
A114624E03
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (I1-1) or IG2 (I18-6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (I2-1) or IG2 (I18-6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (I3-1) or IG2 (I18-6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (I4-1) or IG2 (I18-6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (I5-1) or IG2 (I18-6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (I6-1) or IG2 (I18-6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–211
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Bank 1)
DTC
P0430
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Bank 2)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses sensors mounted in front of and behind the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) to
monitor its efficiency.
The first sensor, the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, sends pre-catalyst information to the ECM. The second
sensor, the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor, sends post-catalyst information to the ECM.
In order to detect any deterioration in the TWC, the ECM calculates the Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC)
of the TWC. This calculation is based on the voltage output of the HO2 sensor while performing active airfuel ratio control, rather than the conventional detecting method, which uses the locus ratio.
The OSC value is an indication of the oxygen storage capacity of the TWC. When the vehicle is being
driven with a warm engine, active air-fuel ratio control is performed for approximately 15 to 20 seconds.
When it is performed, the ECM deliberately sets the air-fuel ratio to lean or rich levels. If a rich-lean cycle
of the HO2 sensor is long, the OSC becomes greater. There is a direct correlation between the OSCs of
the HO2 sensor and the TWC.
The ECM uses the OSC value to determine the state of the TWC. If any deterioration has occurred, it
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P0420
OSC value smaller than standard value under active
air-fuel ratio control (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
P0430
OSC value smaller than standard value under active
air-fuel ratio control (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Gas leakage from exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
HO2 sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Exhaust manifold (TWC)
Gas leakage from exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
Exhaust manifold (TWC)
HINT:
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0420: Catalyst (Bank 1) Deterioration
P0430: Catalyst (Bank 2) Deterioration
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
A/F sensor, Rear HO2S
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Rear HO2S, IAT sensor, MAF meter, Crankshaft position sensor, ECT sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
30 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
ES–212
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0011, P0012 (VVT System1-Advance, Retard), P0021, P0022 (VVT System2Adavance, Retard), P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F Sensor Heater Sensor 1),
P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 (O2 Sensor heater Sensor 2), P0100, P0101, P0102,
P0103 (MAF Sensor), P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor), P0120, P0121,
P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 , P2135 (TP Sensor), P0125 (Insufficient ECT
for Closed Loop), P0136, P0156 (O2 Sensor 2), P0171,P0172 (Fuel System),
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306 (Misfire), P0335 (CKP
Sensor), P0340 (CMP Sensor), P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354, P0355, P0356
(Ignitor), P0500 (VSS), P2196, P2198 (A/F Sensor (Rationality)), P2A00, P2A03 (A/
F Sensor (Slow Response))
Battery voltage
11 V or more
IAT
-10°C (14°F) or more
ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
Atmospheric pressure coefficient
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine RPM
Less than 3.200 rpm
A/F sensor
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed loop
Engine load
10 to 70%
All of the following conditions are met
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. MAF
5 to 70 g/sec.
2. Front catalyst temperature (estimated)
650 to 720°C (1,202 to 1,328°F)
3. Rear catalyst temperature (estimated)
100 to 900°C (212 to 1,652°F)
A/F sensor
Completed
Rear HO2S
Completed
Shift position
4th or higher
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC) of catalyst
Less than 0.08 g
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to Checking Monitor Status (See page ES-14).
CONDITIONING FOR SENSOR TESTING
HINT:
Perform the operation with the engine speeds and time durations described below prior to check the
waveforms of the A/F and HO2 sensors. This is in order to activate the sensors sufficiently to obtain the
appropriate inspection results.
ES–213
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Engine Speed
“C”
3,000 rpm
“D”
“D”
2,000 rpm
Idling
“B”
“A”
Time
Ignition Switch OFF
Warming up
At least 3 minutes
2 seconds
ES
2 seconds
A093766E19
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (Procedure "A").
2. Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories switched off, until the engine coolant
temperature stabilizes (Procedure "B").
3. Run the engine at an engine speed of between 2,500 rpm and 3,000 rpm for at least 3 minutes
(Procedure "C").
4. While running the engine at 3,000 rpm for 2 seconds and 2,000 rpm for 2 seconds, check the
waveforms of the A/F and HO2 sensors using the tester (Procedure "D").
HINT:
• If either of the voltage outputs of the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) or Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor does not
fluctuate, or either of the sensors makes a noise, the sensor may be malfunctioning.
• If the voltage outputs of both the sensors remain lean or rich, the air-fuel ratio may be extremely
lean or rich. In such cases, perform the following A/F CONTROL using the intelligent tester.
• If the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) has deteriorated, the HO2 sensor (located behind the
TWC) voltage output fluctuates up and down frequently, even under normal driving conditions
(active air-fuel ratio control is not performed).
Voltage output when active air-fuel ratio control not performed:
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of
A/F Sensor in
front of TWC
Deteriorated Catalyst
3.5 V
3.0 V
Waveform of
HO2 Sensor
behind TWC
1.0 V
0V
10 seconds
10 seconds
A076893E08
ES–214
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1.
ES
A/F CONTROL
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the
ACTIVE TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor, Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using an intelligent
tester.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and turn the tester on.
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(d) On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE
TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(e) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or
LEFT button to change the fuel injection volume).
(f) Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS
B2S1 and O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the
injection volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
3
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
ES–215
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
•
•
•
4
Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air-fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check the graph the voltage
outputs of both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2, press the YES button and then the ENTER button
followed by the F4 button.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0420 AND/OR P0430)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0420 and/or P0430
A
P0420 and/or P0430 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0420 or P0430 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/F CONTROL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and turn the tester on.
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for
approximately 90 seconds.
(d) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
ES
ES–216
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(e) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in
an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT button to
change the fuel injection volume).
(f) Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors
(AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection
volume by 12.5% or increases the injection volume by
25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and
decreases in the fuel injection volume.
ES
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
Result
Status AFS
B1S1 or AFS
B2S1
Status O2S
B1S2 or O2S
B2S2
A/F Condition and A/F and
HO2 Sensor Conditions
Misfires
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
Lean/Rich
Lean/Rich
Normal
-
Lean
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor malfunction
-
Rich
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor malfunction
•
Three-Way Catalytic
Converter (TWC)
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Proceed to
A
A/F sensor
B
-
A/F sensor
B
HO2 sensor
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
C
Lean/Rich
Lean
HO2 sensor malfunction
-
•
•
Lean/Rich
Rich
HO2 sensor malfunction
-
•
•
HO2 sensor
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
C
•
Extremely rich or lean
actual air-fuel ratio
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
A
Extremely rich or lean
actual air-fuel ratio
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
A
Lean
Lean
Actual air-fuel ratio lean
May occur
•
•
Rich
Rich
Actual air-fuel ratio rich
-
•
Lean: During A/F CONTROL, the A/F sensor output
voltage (AFS) is consistently more than 3.35 V, and the
HO2 sensor output voltage (O2S) is consistently less
than 0.4 V.
Rich: During A/F CONTROL, the AFS is consistently less
than 3.0 V, and the O2S is consistently more than 0.55 V.
Lean/Rich: During A/F CONTROL of the ACTIVE TEST,
the output voltage of the HO2 sensor alternates
correctly.
B
CHECK AND REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO
SENSOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
C
ES–217
CHECK AND REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR, AND CHECK AND REPAIR
EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
A
3
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
OK:
No gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST GAS
LEAKAGE POINT
OK
REPLACE THREE-WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (FRONT EXHAUST PIPE)
ES
ES–218
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P043E
Evaporative Emission System Reference Orifice Clog Up
DTC
P043F
Evaporative Emission System Reference Orifice High Flow
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
Monitoring Items
Malfunction Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
•
ES
P043E
P043F
0.02 inch orifice clogged
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and
P2419 present when one of following
conditions met during key-off EVAP
monitor:
• EVAP pressure just after reference
pressure measurement greater than
-1 kPa-g (-7.5 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure less than -4.85
kPa-g (-36.4 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure greater than 1.057 kPa-g (-7.93 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure not saturated
• Reference pressure difference
between first and second 0.7 kPa-g
(5.25 mmHg-g) or more
HINT:
Typical example values
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Canister pump module
(Reference orifice,
leak detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet port
to canister pump
module, canister filter,
fuel tank vent hose)
ECM
While
ignition
switch OFF
2 trip
Canister pump module
(Reference orifice,
leak detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet port
to canister pump
module, canister filter,
fuel tank vent hose)
ECM
While
ignition
switch OFF
2 trip
*
: The threshold values vary according to the atmospheric pressure measured at the EVAP monitor
beginning. The values described in the table above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa
(750.1 mmHg) (absolute pressure).
HINT:
The 0.02 inch orifice is located inside the pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-346).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP System (See page ES-349).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours*1 after the ignition switch is turned to off, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator
malfunctions based on the EVAP pressure.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–219
HINT:
*1: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
*2
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
-
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch
turned off.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525
mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump
creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then
ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) is created in EVAP system, and EVAP
system pressure then measured. Write down measured value as it will
be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels
EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*2
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV is opened and then EVAP system pressure is measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak pressure measurement, leak check is
performed by comparing first and second 0.02 inch leak pressure
standards.
If stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard, ECM determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure is measured and then monitoring result is
recorded by ECM.
-
ES
-
: If there is only a small amount of fuel in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES–220
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation A:
Operation B, E:
Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
Purge VSV:
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF
OFF
(vent)
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Vacuum Pump: OFF
ES
Pump Module
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON (closed)
ON
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
(closed)
ON
A096746E18
ES–221
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P043E: 0.02 inch orifice clogged
In operation B, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the 0.02 inch orifice.
The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM, using the pressure sensor, to determine the
0.02 inch leak pressure standard. If the pressure is lower than -4.3 kPa (-36.4 mmHg)*, the ECM
interprets this as a clog malfunction in the 0.02 inch orifice, and stops the EVAP (Evaporative
Emission) system monitor.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when 0.02 Inch Orifice Clogged:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Malfunction
Sequence
Time
A
B
C
10 seconds
60 seconds
With 15 minutes
D
E
60 seconds
10
seconds
F
G036773E07
ES
ES–222
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P043F: 0.02 inch orifice high-flow
In operation B, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the 0.02 inch orifice.
The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the pressure sensor to determine the
0.02 inch leak pressure standard. If the pressure is higher than -1.057 kPa (-7.93 mmHg)*, the ECM
interprets this as a high-flow malfunction in the 0.02 inch orifice, and stops the EVAP system monitor.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*
: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on a atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when 0.02 Inch Orifice High-flow Malfunction:
ES
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
B
C
10 seconds
60 seconds
With 15 minutes
D
E
60 seconds
10
seconds
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P043E: 0.02 inch orifice clog (built-in pump module)
P043F: 0.02 inch orifice high-flow (built-in pump module)
Required Sensors / Components
Pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 2 minutes (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452,
P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
F
G036774E07
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–223
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
One of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. EVAP pressure just after reference pressure
measurement start
More than -1 kPa (-7.93 mmHg)
2. Reference pressure
Less than -4.85 kPa (-36.4 mmHg)
3. Reference pressure
-1.057 kPa (-7.93 mmHg) or more
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated within 60 seconds
5. Difference between first reference pressure and
second reference pressure
0.7 kPa (5..25 mmHg) or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES
ES–224
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect
Purge Flow
P0441
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
P0441
Monitoring Items
Purge VSV (Vacuum
Switching Valve) stuck
open
Vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in EVAP system and EVAP
system pressure is measured. The 0.02
inch leak pressure standard is measured
at the start and end of the leak check.
If stabilized pressure is higher than
[second 0.02 inch leak pressure
standard x 0.2], ECM determines that
purge VSV is stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
After EVAP leak check performed, purge
VSV turned ON (open), and atmospheric
air is introduced into EVAP system. 0.02
inch leak pressure standard is measured
at the start and end of leak check.
If pressure does not return to near
atmospheric pressure, ECM determines
that purge valve is stuck closed
Purge flow
While engine running, the following
conditions successively met:
• Negative pressure is not created in
EVAP system when purge VSV is
turned ON (open)
• EVAP system pressure change is
less than 1 kPa (7.5 mmHg) when
vent valve is turned ON (closed)
• Atmospheric pressure change before
and after purge flow monitor is less
than 1 kPa (0.75 mmHg)
ES
P0441
P0441
Malfunction Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(Purge VSV - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Leakage from EVAP
system
While
ignition
Switch OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(Purge VSV - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Leakage from EVAP
system
While
ignition
Switch OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(Purge VSV - ECM)
Leakage from EVAP
line
(Purge VSV - Intake
manifold)
ECM
While
engine
running
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-346).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP System (See page ES-349).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The two monitors, Key-Off and Purge Flow, are used to detect malfunctions relating to DTC P0441. The
Key-Off monitor is initiated by the ECM internal timer, known as the soak timer, 5 hours*1 after the ignition
switch is turned to off. The purge flow monitor runs while the engine is running.
1. KEY-OFF MONITOR
5 hours*1 after the ignition switch is turned off, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator
malfunctions based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*1: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the
ignition switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
Operations
ECM activation
Descriptions
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch
turned off.
Duration
-
ES–225
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
10 seconds
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525
mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
B
First 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump
creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then
ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) is created in EVAP system, and EVAP
system pressure then measured.
Write down measured value as it will be used in the leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels
EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*2
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV is opened and then EVAP system pressure is measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak pressure measurement, leak check is
performed by comparing first and second 0.02 inch leak pressure
standards.
If stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard, ECM determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure is measured and then monitoring result is
recorded by ECM.
*2:
-
If only a small amount of fuel in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A:
Operation B, E:
Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
Purge VSV:
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF
OFF
(vent)
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Vacuum Pump: OFF
Pump Module
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON (closed)
ON
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
(closed)
ON
A096746E18
ES
ES–226
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a) Purge VSV stuck open
In operation C, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative
Emission) system. The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the pressure
sensor. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard
x 0.2], the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve) being stuck open.
The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Open:
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ES
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
[Second 0.02 lnch
Leak Pressure
Standard] x 0.2
OK
Sequence
A
Time
10 seconds
B
60 seconds
C
Within 15 minutes
D
E
10
60 seconds
seconds
G036775E08
ES–227
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Purge VSV stuck closed
In operation D, the pressure sensor measures the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system
pressure. The pressure measurement for purge VSV monitor is begun when the purge VSV is
turned on (open) after the EVAP leak check. When the measured pressure indicates an increase
of 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more, the purge VSV is functioning normally. If the pressure does not
increase, the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being stuck closed. The ECM illuminates the
MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Closed:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ES
ON: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
Malfunction
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
B
10 seconds
C
60 seconds
Within 15 minutes
D
E
60 seconds
10
seconds
G036776E14
2.
EVAP Pressure During Purge Flow Monitor:
Open
Purge VSV
ON
(Closed)
Vent Valve
Malfunction
0.1 kPa
EVAP
Pressure
OK
1st Monitor
0.5 kPa
OK
2nd Monitor
A071563E10
PURGE FLOW MONITOR
The purge flow monitor consists of the two step monitors.
The 1st monitor is conducted every time and the 2nd
monitor is activated if necessary.
• The 1st monitor
While the engine is running and the purge VSV
(Vacuum Switching Valve) is on (open), the ECM
monitors the purge flow by measuring the EVAP
pressure change. If negative pressure is not created,
the ECM begins the 2nd monitor.
• The 2nd monitor
The vent valve is turned on (closed) and the EVAP
pressure is then measured. If the variation in the
pressure is less than 1 kPa (7.5 mmHg), the ECM
interprets this as the purge VSV being stuck closed,
and illuminates the MIL and sets DTC P0441 (2 trip
detection logic).
Atmospheric pressure check:
In order to ensure reliable malfunction detection, the
variation between the atmospheric pressures, before
and after conduction of the purge flow monitor, is
measured by the ECM.
ES–228
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0441: Purge VSV stuck open
P0441: Purge VSV stuck closed
P0441: Purge flow
Required Sensors / Components
Purge VSV and pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Purge VSV stuck open and closed: Within 15 minutes. (varies with amount of fuel in
tank)
Purge flow: Within 10 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor is run whenever this DTC is not present
P0011, P0012 (VVT System-Advance, Retard), P0021, P0022 (VVT System2Adavance, Retard), P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF Sensor), P0110, P0112,
P0113 (IAT Sensor),P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor), P0120, P0121,
P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 , P2135 (TP Sensor), P0125 (Insufficient ECT
for Closed Loop), P0171,P0172 (Fuel System), P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306 (Misfire), P0335 (CKP Sensor), P0340 (CMP sensor), P0351,
P0352, P0353, P0354, P0355, P0356 (Ignitor), P0450, P0451, P0452, P0453 (EVAP
pressure Sensor), P0500 (VSS)
Purge VSV stuck open and closed:
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key-off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452,
P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
Purge flow:
Engine
Running
ECT
4.4°C (40°F) or more
IAT
4.4°C (40°F) or more
EVAP pressure sensor
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP system check
Not operated by scan tool
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Purge duty cycle
8% or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Purge flow:
Both of the following conditions are met
Condition (a) and (b)
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a) EVAP pressure change when purge flow is started
Less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg)
(b) EVAP pressure change during purge flow when
EVAP pressure switching valve ON (closed)
Less than 0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg)
ES–229
EVAP VSV stuck open:
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.2
EVAP VSV stuck closed:
EVAP pressure change after EVAP canister purge
valve is open
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES
ES–230
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0450
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch
DTC
P0451
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor Range / Performance
DTC
P0452
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch Low Input
DTC
P0453
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch High Input
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
Monitoring Items
P0450
Pressure sensor abnormal
voltage fluctuation
P0451
Pressure sensor noising
Malfunction Detection
Conditions
Sensor output voltage rapidly
fluctuates beyond upper and
lower malfunction thresholds for
0.5 seconds.
Sensor output voltage fluctuates
frequently in certain time period.
•
•
•
Pressure sensor stuck
Sensor output voltage does vary
in certain time period.
•
•
•
•
•
P0452
Pressure sensor voltage
low
Sensor output voltage is less than
0.45 V for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
P0453
Pressure sensor voltage
high
Sensor output voltage is more
than 4.9 V for 0.5 seconds.
Pump module
ECM
•
•
P0451
Detection
Timings
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Pump module
Connector/wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector/wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector/wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector/wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
•
•
Detection
Logic
EVAP
monitoring
(ignition OFF)
Ignition ON
1 trip
EVAP
monitoring
(ignition OFF)
Engine running
2 trip
EVAP monitoring
(ignition OFF)
2 trip
•
•
Ignition ON
EVAP
monitoring
(ignition OFF)
1 trip
•
•
Ignition ON
EVAP
monitoring
(ignition OFF)
1 trip
HINT:
The pressure sensor is built into the pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-346).
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–231
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Pressure Sensor Specification:
Output Voltage
Malfunction Area
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
Pressure
60 kPa
110 kPa
HINT:
Standard Atmospheric Pressure is 101.3 kPa
A071562E16
1. DTC P0450: Pressure sensor abnormal voltage fluctuation
If the pressure sensor voltage output rapidly fluctuates between less than 0.45 V and more than 4.9 V,
the ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit malfunction in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and
stops the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
2. DTC P0451: Pressure sensor noising or stuck
If the pressure sensor voltage output fluctuates rapidly for 10 seconds, the ECM stops the EVAP
system monitor. The ECM interprets this as noise from the pressure sensor, and stops the EVAP
system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
Alternatively, if the sensor voltage output does not change for 10 seconds, the ECM interprets this as
the sensor being stuck, and stops the monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
(Both the malfunctions are detected by 2 trip detection logic)
3. DTC P0452: Pressure sensor voltage low
If the pressure sensor voltage output is below 0.45 V, the ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit
malfunction in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
4. DTC P0453: Pressure sensor voltage high
If the pressure sensor voltage output is 4.9 V or more, the ECM interprets this as an open or short
circuit malfunction in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM
then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0450: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor/switch chattering
P0451: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor noise
P0451: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor stuck
P0452: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor/switch low input
P0453: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor/switch high input
Required Sensors / Components
Pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once pre driving cycle
Duration
0.5 seconds: P0450, P0452, P0453
Within 15 seconds: P0451
MIL Operation
Immediate: P0450, P0452, P0453
2 driving cycles: P0451
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
ES–232
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Pressure sensor noise:
ES
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452,
P0453)
Not detected
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
2. Engine condition
Running
Pressure sensor stuck
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452,
P0453)
Not detected
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
Pressure sensor chattering, low/high voltage
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Pressure sensor noise:
Frequency that EVAP pressure change is 0.3 kPa (2.25
mmHg) or more
10 times or more in 10 seconds
Pressure sensor stuck:
EVAP pressure change during reference pressure
measurement
Less than 1 kPa (0.75 mmHg)
Pressure sensor chattering:
EVAP pressure
Less than 42.11 kPa (315.82mmHg), or more than 123.761 kPa (928.207 mmHg)
Pressure sensor low pressure:
EVAP pressure
Less than 42.11 kPa (315.82 mmHg)
Pressure sensor high pressure:
EVAP pressure
More than 123.761 kPa (928.207 mmHg)
ES–233
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
L4
Canister Pump Module
Pressure Sensor
42
IE1
L-R
R
17
IE1
R
BR
43
IE1
BR
O
28
IE1
O
6
E8 MPMP
11
IE1
R-G
5
E8 VPMP
L-R
4
3
Vacuum Pump
2
6
1
R-G
8
W-B
ECM
Vent Valve
L-W
9
1
IB2
7
IM2
22
BR
IM2
L-W
G-Y
A
J4
J/C
A
9 IE1
A
L-W
L
EFI
1
W-B
12
IM1
L-W
8
E8 MREL
2
1
2
B
W-G
EFI Relay
2
34
E4 PRG
EFI No. 2
2
W-B
2
2
ES
1
L-W
Engine Room R/B
2
17 IM2
28
E2
E4
V2
2
Purge
VSV
17 IC3
Engine
Room R/B
23 VC
E4
22
PPMP
E8
L-W
W-B
L-R
5
3
2
1
B
J2
B
J3
IC4 35
2
2
W-G
2
B
W-B
J/C
EF
Battery
EB
G032687E01
ES–234
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When a vehicle is brought into the workshop, leave it as it is. Do not change the vehicle
condition. For example, do not tighten the fuel tank cap.
• Do not disassemble the pump module.
• The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting
procedure.
1
CONFIRM DTC AND EVAP PRESSURE
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on (do not start the engine).
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / VAPOR
PRESS.
(g) Read the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) pressure
displayed on the tester.
ES
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Test Results
P0451
-
Suspected Trouble Areas
Pressure sensor
•
P0452
Less than 45 kpa (338 mmHg)
•
•
•
P0453
More than 120 kPa (900 mmHg)
B
C
•
•
Proceed to
C
Wire harness/connector
(ECM - pressure sensor)
Pressure sensor
Short in ECM circuit
A
Wire harness/connector
(ECM - pressure sensor)
Pressure sensor
Open in ECM circuit
B
Go to step 4
GO TO EVAP SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PUMP MODULE - ECM)
ECM:
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between PPMP terminal of the
ECM connector and the body ground.
E8
PPMP
G035619E14
ES–235
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
10 Ω or less
•
•
10 Ω or more
•
Proceed to
Wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure
sensor)
Short in pressure sensor circuit
A
Wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure
sensor)
Short in ECM circuit
B
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
B
Go to step 8
A
ES
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between PPMP terminal of the
ECM connector and the body ground.
L4
ECM:
E8
PPMP
A138722E01
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
10 kΩ or more
Short in pressure sensor circuit
A
10 kΩ or less
Short in wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure
sensor)
B
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
B
Go to step 6
A
4
REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace charcoal canister assembly (See page EC-6).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
ES–236
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(d) Wait for at least 60 seconds.
(e) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the tester, the repair
has been successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
ES
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage and resistance of the L4 canister
connector.
Standard
L4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
L4-4 - Body ground
Between 4.5 V and 5.5 V
L4-3 - Body ground
Between 4.5 V and 5.5 V
L4-2 - Body ground
100 Ω or less
Wire Harness Side:
Canister Connector
L4
Front View
A138723E01
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Voltage and resistance is within standard ranges
Open in pressure sensor circuit
A
Voltage and resistance is outside standard ranges
Open in wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure
sensor)
B
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 7
A
6
REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace charcoal canister assembly (See page EC-6).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–237
(c) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(d) Wait for at least 60 seconds.
(e) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the tester, the repair
has been successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
ES
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS OR CONNECTORS
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Repair or replace wire harness or connectors.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Wait for at least 60 seconds.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the tester, the repair
has been successfully completed.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Replace the ECM (See page ES-434).
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Wait for at least 60 seconds.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the tester, the repair
has been successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
8
REPLACE ECM
NEXT
COMPLETED
ES–238
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0455
Evaporative Emission Control System Leak
Detected (Gross Leak)
DTC
P0456
Evaporative Emission Control System Leak
Detected (Very Small Leak)
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
ES
P0455
P0456
Malfunction Detection
Conditions
Monitoring Items
EVAP gross leak
EVAP small leak
Vacuum pump creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in EVAP
system and EVAP system
pressure is measured. The 0.02
inch leak pressure standard is
measured at the start and end of
the leak check.
If stabilized pressure is higher
than [second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard x 0.2], ECM
determines that EVAP system
has large leakage.
Vacuum pump creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in EVAP
system and EVAP system
pressure measured. The 0.02
inch leak pressure standard
measured at the start and end of
the leak check.
If stabilized pressure is higher
than second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard, ECM
determines that EVAP system
has small leakage.
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
Fuel tank cap (loose)
Leakage from EVAP
line (Canister - Fuel
tank)
Leakage from EVAP
line (Purge VSV Canister)
Leakage from pump
module
Leakage from fuel
tank
Leakage from canister
Same above
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
While ignition
switch OFF
2 trip
While ignition
switch OFF
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-346).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP System (See page ES-349).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours*1 after the ignition switch is turned off, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator
malfunctions based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*1: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) after 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Operations
Descriptions
-
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch
turned off.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525
mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
Duration
-
10 seconds
ES–239
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
First 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump
creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then
ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) is created in EVAP system, and EVAP
system pressure then measured.
Write down measured value as it will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels
EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*2
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV is opened and then EVAP system pressure is measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak pressure measurement, leak check is
performed by comparing first and second 0.02 inch leak pressure
standards.
If stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard, ECM determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure is measured and then monitoring result is
recorded by ECM.
B
ES
-
*2
: If only a small amount of fuel in the fuel tank, it take longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A:
Operation B, E:
Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
Purge VSV:
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF
OFF
(vent)
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Vacuum Pump: OFF
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
Pump Module
ON (closed)
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
(closed)
ON
A096746E18
1. P0455: EVAP (Evaporative Emission) gross leak
In operation C, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the
EVAP system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02 inch
leak pressure standard x 0.2] (near atmospheric pressure), the ECM determines that the EVAP system
has a large leakage, illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
ES–240
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P0456: EVAP very small leak
In operation C, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the
EVAP system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch
leak pressure standard, the ECM determines that the EVAP system has a small leakage, illuminates
the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when EVAP System Leaks:
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ES
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
P0455
Positive
Negative
P0456
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
OK
Sequence
Time
A
B
10 seconds
60 seconds
C
With 15 minutes
[Second 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard] x 0.2
D
60 seconds
10
seconds
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0455: Gross leak detected
P0456: Very small leak (0.020 inch hole) detected
Required Sensors / Components
Purge VSV, pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 minutes (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key-off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452,
P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
E
F
G038299E06
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–241
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Small leak (0.020 inch) malfunction detection:
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Between reference pressure and reference pressure x 0.2
Gross leak detection:
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.2
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES
ES–242
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles, which are equipped with ABS (Anti-lock Brake System), detect the vehicle speed using the skid
control ECU and wheel speed sensor. The wheel speed sensor monitors the wheel rotation speed and
sends a signal to the skid control ECU. The skid control ECU converts the wheel speed signal into a 4pulse signal and transmits it to the ECM via the combination meter. The ECM determines the vehicle
speed based on the frequency of the pulse signal.
4-Pulse
ES
From Speed
Sensor
4-Pulse
Skid Control
ECU
ECM
Combination Mater
A079413E17
DTC No.
P0500
DTC Detection Conditions
The ECM detects following conditions simultaneously
500 times (2 trip detection logic)
• No SP1 (speed sensor) signal while ECM detects
SP2 (No. 2 speed sensor) signal
• Vehicle speed is 6 mph (9 km/h) or more for 4
seconds
• Park/Neutral position switch is OFF (shift lever
other than P and N positions)
• Transfer lever is in other than N position (4WD)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Open or short in speed signal circuit
Combination meter
ECM
Skid control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM assumes that the vehicle is being driven, the vehicle speed sensor signal is being transmitted
by the combination meter. If there is no signal from combination meter, despite the ECM detects the
speed signal from speed sensor No. 2, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the speed signal circuit.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0500: Vehicle speed sensor "A" pulse input error
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Park/neutral Position switch, Engine Coolant Temperature sensor, Combination
meter
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
ES–243
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
-
Vehicle speed is 5.59 mph (9 km/h) or more
4 seconds or more
Park/neutral position switch
OFF
Ignition switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
2WD:
Sensor signal
No input
4WD:
Either of following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of following conditions (a), (b) and (c) met
-
(a) Sensor signal
No input
(b) Output speed sensor input
16 pulse
(c) Transfer L4 Switch
OFF
2. All of following conditions (a), (b) and (c) met
-
(a) Sensor signal
No input
(b) Output speed sensor input
41 pulse
(c) Transfer L4 Switch
ON
ES
WIRING DIAGRAM
C9
Combination Meter
5 V-R
ECM
Driver Side J/B
1
1G
11
1K
Center J/B
V-R
B
3D
B
3D
V-R
G
J29
J/C
G
J30
V-R
8
E7
SPD
G032688E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
ES–244
1
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the
speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the
speedometer reading is normal.
NG
ES
CHECK SPEEDOMETER CIRCUIT
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (SPD VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ECM:
E6
E1 (-)
E7
Shift the shift lever to the neutral position.
Jack up the vehicle.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Check the voltage between the terminals of the E6 and
E7 ECM connectors as the wheel is turned slowly.
OK
NG
Turn Wheel
A114628E03
OK
REPLACE ECM
Specified Conditions
Voltage generated intermittently
HINT:
The output voltage should fluctuate up and down
similarly to the diagram on the left when the wheel is
turned slowly.
SPD (+)
4.5 to 14 V
0V
Tester Connections
SPD (E7-8) - E1 (E6-1)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–245
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0504
Brake Switch "A" / "B" Correlation
DESCRIPTION
The stop light switch is a duplex system that transmits two signals: STP and ST1-. These two signals are
used by the ECM to monitor whether or not the brake system is working properly. If the signals, which
indicate the brake pedal is being depressed or released, are detected simultaneously, the ECM interprets
this as a malfunction in the stop light switch and sets the DTC.
HINT:
The normal conditions are as shown in the table below. The signals can be read using the intelligent
tester.
Signals
Brake Pedal Released
In Transition
Brake Pedal Depressed
STP
OFF
ON
ON
ST1-
ON
ON
OFF
DTC No.
P0504
DTC Detection Conditions
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for 0.5 seconds or
more (1 trip detection logic):
(a) Ignition switch on
(b) Brake pedal released
(c) STP signal OFF when ST1- signal OFF
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
STOP fuse
Stop light switch
ECM
ES
ES–246
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
G-Y
15
E8 STP
R-L
16
E8 ST1-
B-R
Driver Side J/B
ES
To Towing
Brake
Controller
11 IC3
J/C
H J31
IGN
6
1D
E J32
12
1J
24
1E
S12
Stop Light SW
3
4
G-W
Center J/B
E
3C
J4
J/C
B-O
R-L
G-Y
23
1E
B-O
C
C
G-Y
1
2
E
3C
G-Y
15
IC3
G-B
S28 Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
B
G-Y
B
G-Y
G-Y
B
B
Engine Room R/B
45
STP2
2
E
4
2
G-W
5
3
1
2
2
G-B
2
1
2
1
2
7
16
2
2
E
LG
2
ALT
STOP
G-B
E
STP
STPO
From IG1 Fuse
B
I18
Ignition SW
2
B
AM2
2
1
2
2
R
7 AM2
IG2 6
Battery
G032694E01
ES–247
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK OPERATION OF STOP LIGHT
(a) Check whether the stop lights turn on and off normally
when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK:
Stop lights turn on when brake pedal is depressed.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
2
Free
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Pushed in
2
4
1
3
A072924E24
(a) Remove the stop light switch assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance
Switch Positions
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the stop light switch assembly.
NG
OK
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–248
3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STP SIGNAL AND ST1 - VOLTAGE)
Brake Pedal
Depressed
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / STOP
LIGHT SW.
(d) Check the STP signal when the brake pedal is
depressed and released.
Standard
Brake Pedal
Released
ES
ECM:
E6
Specified Conditions
Depressed
STP signal ON
Released
STP signal OFF
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E6
and E8 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E8
E1 (-)
Brake Pedal Operations
ST1- (+)
G035663E06
Tester Connections
Brake Pedal Operations
Specified Conditions
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
Depressed
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
Released
7.5 to 14 V
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (STOP LIGHT SWITCH - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the S12 stop light switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Stop Light Switch Connector
S12
1
3
2
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Stop light switch (S12-1) - STP (E8-15)
Below 1 Ω
Stop light switch (S12-4) - ST1- (E8-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Stop light switch (S12-1) or STP (E8-15) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Stop light switch (S12-4) or ST1- (E8-16) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Front View
ECM:
E8
(d) Reconnect the stop light switch connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
ST1STP
A114629E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–249
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–250
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The idling speed is controlled by the ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System). The ETCS is comprised
of: 1) the one valve type throttle body; 2) the throttle actuator, which operates the throttle valve; 3) the
Throttle Position (TP) sensor, which detects the opening angle of the throttle valve; 4) the Accelerator
Pedal Position (APP) sensor, which detects the accelerator pedal position; and 5) the ECM, which
controls the ETCS.
Based on the target idling speed, the ECM controls the throttle actuator to provide the proper throttle valve
opening angle.
DTC No.
ES
P0505
DTC Detection Conditions
Idling speed continues to vary greatly from target idling
speed (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
ETCS
Air induction system
PCV hose connection
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the idling speed and idling air flow volume to conduct Idle Speed Control (ISC). The
ECM determines that the ISC system is malfunctioning if the following conditions apply:
• The learned idling air flow volume remains at the maximum or minimum volume 5 times or more during
a drive cycle.
• While driving at 6 mph (10 km/h) or more, the actual engine idling speed varies from the target idling
speed by between 100 rpm and 200 rpm, 5 times or more during a drive cycle.
ES–251
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Example:
If the actual idling speed varies from the target idling speed by more than 200 rpm* 5 times during a drive
cycle, the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
*: Threshold idling speed varies with engine load.
Example:
Idling Speed
Learned Idling Air Volume
Maximum
ES
Large
Target Speed
0
Minimum
Actual Idling Speed
Small
Time
Time
A082389E22
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0505: Idle air control malfunction
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
ETCS
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Engine coolant temperature sensor, Vehicle speed sensor, Crankshaft position
sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
10 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTC is not present
None
Engine
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Frequency that both of following conditions (a) and
(b) are met
5 times or more
(a) Engine RPM - Target engine RPM
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 150 rpm
ES–252
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Vehicle condition
Stop after vehicle was driven by 6.25 mph (10 km/h) or more
2. Frequency that both of following conditions (a) and
(b) are met
Once
(a) Engine RPM - Target engine RPM
Below -100 rpm, 150 rpm or more
(b) IAC flow rate learning valve
1.3 L/sec. or less, or 8.5 L/sec. or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
• The following conditions may also cause DTC P0505 to be set:
(a)The floor carpet overlapping slightly onto the accelerator pedal, causing the accelerator pedal to be
slightly depressed and therefore the throttle valve position to be slightly open.
(b)The accelerator pedal being not fully released.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0505)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0505
A
P0505 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0505 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK PCV HOSE CONNECTIONS
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and is not damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–253
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Check the throttle valve condition.
OK:
Normal
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–20
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE
PATTERN
1.
ES
PURPOSE OF READINESS TESTS
• The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) system is
designed to monitor the performance of emission
related components, and indicate any detected
abnormalities with DTCs (Diagnostic Trouble Codes).
Since various components need to be monitored
during different driving conditions, the OBD II system
is designed to run separate monitoring programs
called Readiness Monitors.
• The intelligent tester's software must be version 9.0 or
newer to view the Readiness Monitor status. To view
the status, select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR INFO
/ MONITOR STATUS.
• When the Readiness Monitor status reads COMPL
(complete), the necessary conditions have been met
for running the performance tests for that Readiness
Monitor.
• A generic OBD II scan tool can also be used to view
the Readiness Monitor status.
HINT:
Many Inspection and Maintenance (I/M) programs
require a vehicle's Readiness Monitor status to show
COMPL before beginning emission tests.
The Readiness Monitor will be reset to INCMPL
(incomplete) if:
• The ECM has lost battery power or broken a fuse.
• DTCs have been cleared.
• The conditions for running the Readiness Monitor
have not been met.
If the Readiness Monitor status shows INCMPL, follow
the appropriate Readiness Monitor Drive Pattern to
change the status to COMPL.
CAUTION:
Strictly observe posted speed limits, traffic laws, and
road conditions when performing these drive
patterns.
NOTICE:
These drive patterns represent the fastest method of
satisfying all conditions necessary to achieve
complete status for each specific Readiness
Monitor.
In the event of a drive pattern being interrupted
(possibly due to factors such as traffic conditions),
the drive pattern can be resumed. In most cases, the
Readiness Monitor will still achieve complete status
upon completion of the drive pattern.
To ensure completion of the Readiness Monitors,
avoid sudden changes in vehicle load and speed
(driving up and down hills and / or sudden
acceleration).
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–21
Contents:
Steps
Section Titles
1
Catalyst Monitor (Active Air-Fuel Ratio Control Type)
2
EVAP System Monitor (Key-Off Type)
3
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) and Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor Monitors (Active Air-Fuel Ratio Control
Type)
4
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) and Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor Heater Monitors (Front A/F and Rear HO2
Sensor Type)
2.
CATALYST MONITOR (ACTIVE AIR-FUEL RATIO
CONTROL TYPE)
Vehicle Speed
NOTICE:
“F”
Between 40 mph and
70 mph (64 km/h and
113 km/h)
Idling
Ignition Switch off
This test will not be completed if the
vehicle is driven under absolute constant
speed condition such as with cruise
control activated.
“E”
Warm up
10 minutes
Time
(Note: Even when vehicle stops during driving pattern, the test can be resumed)
A079199E66
3.
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• The MIL is OFF
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect an intelligent tester or OBDII scan tool
to the DLC3 (Procedure "A").
(2) Turn the ignition switch on (IG) (Procedure "B").
(3) Turn the tester or scan tool ON (Procedure "C").
(4) Clear DTCs (where set) (See page ES-31)
(Procedure "D").
(5) Start the engine and warm it up (Procedure "E").
(6) Drive the vehicle at between 40 mph and 70
mph (64 km/h and 113 km/h) for at least 10
minutes (Procedure "F").
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester or scan tool.
(2) If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), extend the driving time.
EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR (KEY-OFF TYPE)
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• The fuel tank is less than 90% full.
• The altitude is less than 8,000 ft (2,450 m).
• The vehicle is stationary.
• The engine coolant temperature is between
4.4°C and 35°C (40°F to 95°F).
ES
ES–22
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES
4.
• The intake air temperature is between 4.4°C and
35°C (40°F to 95°F).
• Vehicle was driven in the city area (or on freeway) for 10 minutes or more.
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Turn the ignition switch off and wait for 6 hours.
HINT:
Do not start the engine until checking Readiness
Monitor status. If the engine is started, the step
described above must be repeated.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch on (IG).
(3) Turn the tester or scan tool ON.
(4) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester or scan tool.
If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), restart the engine, make sure that
the preconditions have been met, and then
perform the Monitor Conditions again.
AIR-FUEL RATIO (A/F) AND HEATED OXYGEN (HO2)
SENSOR MONITORS (ACTIVE AIR-FUEL RATIO
CONTROL TYPE)
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• 2 minutes or more have elapsed since the engine
was started.
• The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 75°C
(167°F) or more.
• Cumulative driving time at a vehicle speed of 30
mph (48 km/h) or more exceeds 6 minutes.
• Air-fuel ratio feedback control is performed.
• Fuel-cut control is performed for 8 seconds or
more (for the Rear HO2 Sensor Monitor)
(b) Drive Pattern for front A/F sensor and HO2 sensor
(1) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3
(Procedure "A").
(2) Turn the ignition switch on (IG) (Procedure "B").
(3) Turn the tester ON (Procedure "C").
(4) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31) (Procedure "D").
(5) Start the engine, and warm it up until the ECT
reaches 75°C (167°F) or higher (Procedure "E").
(6) Drive the vehicle at 38 mph (60 km/h) or more
for at least 10 minutes (Procedure "F").
(7) Change the transmission to 2nd gear
(Procedure "G").
(8) Accelerate the vehicle to 40 mph (64 km/h) or
more by depressing the accelerator pedal for at
least 10 seconds (Procedure "H").
(9) Soon after performing procedure "H" above,
release the accelerator pedal for at least 4
seconds without depressing the brake pedal, in
order to execute fuel-cut control (Procedure "I").
ES–23
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(10)Allow the vehicle to decelerate until the vehicle
speed declines to less than 6 mph (10 km/h)
(Procedure "J").
(11)Repeat procedures from "H" through "J" above
at least 3 times in one driving cycle (Procedure
"K").
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester.
(2) If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), make sure that the preconditions
have been met, and then perform procedures
from "E" through "K" in Drive Pattern above.
Monitor Drive Pattern
Accelerator Pedal
Released
(Fuel-cut)
Accelerator Pedal Depressed
ECT: 75°C (167°F) or more
At Least 3 times
Vehicle Speed
“F”
38 to 75 mph
(60 to 120 km/h)
Idling
40 mph (64 km/h)
or more
“E”
“H”
“I”
“J”
6 mph
(10 km/h)
“G”
Time
10 minutes or more
Warming up
10 seconds or more 4 seconds or more
G039003E08
5.
AIR-FUEL RATIO (A/F) AND HEATED OXYGEN (HO2)
SENSOR HEATER MONITORS (FRONT A/F AND
REAR HO2 SENSOR TYPE)
Vehicle Speed
“G”
25 mph
(40 km/h)
Idling
“F”
Ignition Switch off
10 minutes or more
2 minutes or more
A078886E21
ES
ES–24
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• The MIL is OFF
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3
(Procedure "A").
(2) Turn the ignition switch on (IG) (Procedure "B").
(3) Turn the tester or scan tool ON (Procedure "C").
(4) Clear DTCs (where set) (See page ES-31)
(Procedure "D").
(5) Start the engine (Procedure "E").
(6) Allow the engine to idle for 10 minutes or more
(Procedure "F").
(7) Drive the vehicle at 25 mph (40 km/h) or more
for at least 2 minutes (Procedure "G").
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester or scan tool.
If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), make sure that the preconditions
have been met, and repeat procedures through
"E" to "G" described in the Drive Pattern above.
ES–254
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P050A
Cold Start Idle Air Control System Performance
DTC
P050B
Cold Start Ignition Timing Performance
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) controls the engine idling speed. The ETCS operates the
throttle actuator to open and close the throttle valve, and adjusts the intake air amount to achieve the
target idling speed.
In addition, the ECM retards the ignition timing and the ETCS increases the intake air amount to quickly
increase the catalyst temperature at cold start to reduce emissions.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
ES
P050A
P050B
Accumulated intake air amount during 10 seconds of idling
after cold start, less than threshold (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle body assembly
Mass air flow meter
Air induction system
PCV hose connections
VVT system
Air cleaner filter element
ECM
Ignition timing retard value insufficient for 5 seconds or more
during 10 seconds of P050A monitoring duration at cold start
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle body assembly
Mass air flow meter
Air induction system
PCV hose connections
VVT system
Air cleaner filter element
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Timing
Accumulated Intake Air Value
P050B Detected
Pass Detected
(g)
Advanced
5 or more
P050A Detected
Threshold
Threshold
Pass Detected
0
Retarded
10
3
(Second)
3
(Second)
Time
Time
Engine Start
10
Engine Start
A112588E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–255
The ECM monitors the intake air amount during idling and the ignition timing.
When the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is between -10°C and 50 °C (14°F and 122°F), the ECM
calculates the idling intake air amount for 10 seconds, beginning 3 seconds after the engine starts.
When the accumulated value is below the threshold, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the Idle
Speed Control (ISC) system at cold start.
The ECM also monitors the ignition timing at cold start, and judges it to be incorrect when it is advanced to
the same value for a warm engine for 5 seconds or more of the 10 second monitoring period.
Example:
P050A is detected when all conditions below are met (2 trip detection logic).
1. The ECT is between -10°C and 50 °C (14°F and 122°F) when the engine starts.
2. The engine idles for 13 seconds after engine start.
3. The accumulated intake air amount is below the threshold.
The ECM sets the DTC and illuminates the MIL 13 seconds after the engine is next started.
NOTICE:
When the negative battery terminal is disconnected during inspection or repairs, the ISC learning
values are cleared. The ISC learning must be performed by warming up the engine and idling for 5
minutes with the ECT at 75°C (167°F) or more because DTCs cannot be detected with the ISC
learning values cleared.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P050A: Idle speed control problem at cold
P050B: Idle ignition timing problem at cold
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Mass air flow meter
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor, Throttle position sensor,
Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P050A:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Time after engine start
3 seconds or more
Starter
OFF
ECT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or more
ECT
-10°C to 50°C (14°F to 122°F)
Engine idling time
3 seconds or more
Fuel-cut
OFF
Vehicle speed
Less than 1.875 mph (3 km/h)
Time after shift position changed
1 second or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or more
P050B:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Time after engine start
3 seconds or more
Starter
OFF
ECT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or more
ECT
-10°C to 50°C (14°F to 122°F)
Engine idling time
3 seconds or more
Fuel-cut
OFF
Vehicle speed
Less than 1.875 mph (3 km/h)
ES
ES–256
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P050A:
Accumulated air flow amount (Neutral position)
Varies with ECT (Example: Less than 42.5 g)
Accumulated air flow amount (Driving position)
Varies with ECT (Example: Less than 47.5 g)
P050B:
Accumulated time when ignition timing retard value insufficient
5 seconds or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using an intelligent tester. Freeze frame data record the engine condition when
malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other
data, from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P050A AND/OR P050B)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Select the following the menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
P050A and/or P050B
A
P050A and/or P050B and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P050A and P050B are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE USING INTELLIGENT TESTER (FUEL TRIM)
HINT:
Calculate the total fuel trim values to check the characteristic
deviation of the mass air flow meter.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / SHORT
FT #1 and LONG FT #1, or SHORT FT #2 and LONG FT
#2.
(e) Read the values displayed on the tester.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(f)
ES–257
Add together the SHORT FT #1 and LONG FT #1, or
SHORT FT #2 and LONG FT #2 values to obtain the
total FUEL TRIM.
OK:
Total of SHORT FT #1 and LONG FT #1, or SHORT
FT #2 and LONG FT #2 values is between -20 % and
20 %.
OK
Go to step 12
NG
3
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
Warm up the engine.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1 and
VVT CTRL B2.
(e) Check the engine speed while operating the Oil Control
Valve (OCV) using the tester.
OK
Tester Operations
Specified Conditions
OCV OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV ON
Engine idles roughly or stalls (soon after OCV switched from OFF
to ON)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
4
CHECK PCV HOSE CONNECTIONS
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and is not damaged.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
5
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
OK
Go to step 10
ES
ES–258
6
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check that the air cleaner filter element is not
excessively contaminated with dirt or oil.
OK:
Air cleaner filter element is not excessively
contaminated with dirt or oil.
NG
Go to step 11
OK
ES
7
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
Replace the mass air flow meter.
NEXT
8
9
10
CHECK AND REPAIR VVT SYSTEM
NEXT
Go to step 15
NEXT
Go to step 15
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
NEXT
11
Go to step 15
REPLACE AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSEMBLY
NEXT
12
Go to step 15
Go to step 15
CHECK THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Check for deposits around the throttle valve and throttle
valve condition.
OK:
No deposits around throttle valve and throttle valve
moves smoothly.
NG
OK
Go to step 14
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
13
ES–259
REPLACE ECM
Replace the ECM (See page ES-434).
NEXT
14
REPAIR OR REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
NEXT
15
Go to step 15
Go to step 15
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P050A AND/OR P050B)
NOTICE:
In this operation, the engine must be cold (the same level
as the engine coolant temperature recorded in the freeze
frame data).
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
(e) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the tester (See page ES-35).
(f) Start the engine to idle for a minute.
OK:
Stable fast idling.
(g) Read DTCs.
OK:
No DTC output.
NEXT
END
ES
ES–260
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0560
System Voltage
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery supplies electricity to the ECM even when the ignition switch is in the off position. This power
allows the ECM to store data such as DTC history, freeze frame data and fuel trim values. If the battery
voltage falls below a minimum level, these memories are cleared and the ECM determines that there is a
malfunction in the power supply circuit. When the engine is next started, the ECM illuminates the MIL and
sets the DTC.
DTC No.
P0560
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
Open in ECM back up power source circuit (1 trip
detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Open in back up power source circuit
EFI fuse
ECM
HINT:
If DTC P0560 is set, the ECM does not store other DTCs.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560: ECM system voltage
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate (MIL will illuminate after next engine start)
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Stand-by RAM
Initialized
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Battery voltage
Less than 3.5 V
ES–261
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B
2
1
ECM
EFI
2
2
12
IC4
L
L
3
E8
BATT
ES
BR
1
E6 E1
B
Battery
EE
G035643E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
ES–262
1
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK FUSE (EFI FUSE)
Engine
Room R/B:
EFI Fuse
(a) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B and J/B.
(b) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
NG
ES
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE, AND
REPLACE FUSE
A072881E02
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (BATT VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E6
and E8 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E6
E8
NG
E1 (-)
BATT (+)
A131509E44
OK
REPLACE ECM
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
BATT (E8-3) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
Go to step 3
ES–263
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - EFI FUSE, EFI FUSE - BATTERY)
ECM:
E8
(a) Check the harness and the connector between the EFI
fuse and ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
BATT
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
EFI fuse (2) - BATT (E8-3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
EFI fuse (2) or BATT (E8-3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room R/B:
EFI Fuse
A138724E01
(4) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(5) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
(b) Check the harness and the connector between the EFI
fuse and battery.
(1) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B.
(2) Disconnect the negative battery terminal.
(3) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Battery positive terminal - EFI fuse (1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Battery positive terminal or EFI fuse (1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the negative battery cable.
(5) Reinstall the EFI No. 1 fuse.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check that the battery is not depleted.
NG
REPLACE BATTERY
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
ES
ES–402
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – VVT SENSOR
VVT SENSOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
V-BANK COVER
ES
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
VENTILATION
HOSE NO.2
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119786E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – VVT SENSOR
ES–403
ES
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
VVT SENSOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119791E01
ES–264
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Internal Control Module Random Access Memory (RAM) Error
P0604
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal memory status. This self-check ensures that the ECM
functioning properly. It is diagnosed by internal "mirroring" of the main CPU and sub CPU to detect the
Random Access Memory (RAM) errors. If outputs from these CPUs are different and deviate from the
standards, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC immediately.
DTC No.
P0604
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
ECM RAM errors)
Trouble Areas
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
16 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
None
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
RAM mirror check
Fail
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
REPLACE ECM
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the battery negative terminal and wait for 1
minutes.
(d) Connect the battery negative terminal.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(f) Check DTC.
OK:
P0604 is not present.
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–265
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0606
ECM / PCM Processor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal processors (CPUs), A/F sensor transistors and heated oxygen
sensor (HO2S) transistors. This self-check ensures that the ECM functioning properly. These are
diagnosed by internal "mirroring" of the main and sub CPUs to detect the processors error. If outputs from
the processors deviate from the standards, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC immediately.
DTC No.
P0606
DTC Setting Condition
•
•
•
ECM CPUs malfunction
A/F sensor transistors malfunction
HO2S transistors malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Exhaust gas leak
HO2S
ECM
ES
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required sensors/Components (main)
ECM
Required sensors/Components (sub)
APP sensor, TP sensor, Brake switch, Cruise control, A/F sensor, HO2S
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
60 seconds
MIL operation
immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Engine
Running
Estimated A/F sensor temperature
450 - 800°C (842 - 1,472°F)
Estimated HO2S temperature
450 - 800°C (842 - 1,472°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference of main APP and sub APP
0.3 V or more
Difference of main TP and sub TP
0.3 V or more
Difference of main brake switch signal and sub brake
switch signal
Different
Cruise control
Fail
A/F sensor transistors
Fail
HO2S transistors
Fail
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data record the engine condition when
malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other
data, from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Check for exhaust gas leak around the HO2S.
OK:
No leak from the HO2S.
ES–266
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR LEAK
OK
2
CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Warm up the engine.
Fuel-Trim and Rear HO2S Voltage Cross-reference
Fuel-Trim
ES
25%
-12.5%
HO2S Voltage
0.8 V
0.2 V
A144391E01
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Select the tester menus: ENHANCED OBDII, ACTIVE
TEST AND A/F CONTROL.
(d) Check the O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2) values when the A/F
CONTROL is -12.5% (Lean fuel-trim).
(e) Check the O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2) values when the A/F
CONTROL is 25% (Rich fuel-trim).
Standard
A/F CONTROL
O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2)
-12.5%
Less than 0.2 V
25%
More than 0.8 V
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
3
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the battery negative terminal and wait for 1
minute.
(d) Connect the battery negative terminal.
ES–267
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(e) Start the engine.
Monitor Drive Pattern for P0606
Engine Coolant Temperature: 75°C (167°F) or more
km/h (mph)
5 Minutes
80 (50)
60 (35)
ES
Time
0
A144392E01
(f)
Perform the drive pattern.
(1) Warm up the engine.
(2) Accelerate the vehicle until 80 km/h (50 mph) and
stop the vehicle.
(3) Drive the vehicle by 60 to 80 km/h (35 to 50 mph) for
5 minutes or more.
(g) Check DTC.
OK:
P0606 is not present.
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–268
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0607
Control Module Performance
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its main and sub CPUs. This self-check ensures that the ECM
functioning properly. If output from the CPUs are different and deviate from the standards, the ECM will
illuminate the MIL and set a DTC immediately. The ECM also monitors the cruise control cancel circuit. If
this circuit malfunctions, the ECM will set a DTC immediately (MIL is not illuminated).
DTC No.
P0607
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
•
•
•
Trouble Area
ECM main CPU error
ECM sub CPU error
Cruise control cancel circuit malfunction
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required sensors / components (main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (sub)
Throttle actuator (throttle body)
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
16 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
CPU reset
Occurred
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
When either condition below is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. When all conditions below are met:
-
- CPU reset
1 time or more
- Learned TP - Learned APP
0.4 V or more
- Electronic throttle actuator
OFF
2. CPU reset
2 time or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the battery negative terminal and wait for 1
minute.
(d) Connect the battery negative terminal.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(f) Check DTC.
OK:
P0607 is not present.
NG
REPLACE ECM
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–269
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–270
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0617
Starter Relay Circuit High
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
While the engine is being cranked, the positive battery voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM.
If the ECM detects the Starter Control (STA) signal while the vehicle is being driven, it determines that
there is a malfunction in the STA circuit. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
This monitor runs when the vehicle is driven at 12.4 mph (20 km/h) for over 20 seconds.
DTC No.
P0617
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
When conditions (a), (b) and (c) met, when positive
(+B) battery voltage 10.5 V or more is applied to ECM
for 20 seconds (1 trip detection logic):
(a) Vehicle speed more than 12.43 mph (20 km/h)
(b) Engine speed more than 1,000 rpm
(c) STA signal ON
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch
Starter relay circuit
Ignition switch
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0617: Starter signal
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
STARTER relay, PNP switch
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Vehicle Speed Sensor, Crankshaft Position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
20 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
12.43 mph (20 km/h) or more
Engine speed
1,000 rpm or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Starter signal
ON
ES–271
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
8 STAR/
E5 NSW
11
E6 STA
P
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
B-Y
B
J27
J/C
B-Y
B
5
B
P
L-Y
4
IM2
B-Y
11
IM1
12
E6
L-Y
STSW
B-Y
Driver Side J/B
N
4
Center J/B
38
IC4
P
F
3E
F
3E
2
1K
STA No. 2
8
1K
ACC
ES
3
1D
G-B
5
1D
W-G
Engine Room R/B
P
From A/C System
ACC CUT Relay
2
To EFI
Fuse
2
2
4
3
2
2
1
16
IC3
W-G
17
E8
W-G
ACCR
I18
Ignition SW
AM1
ALT
2
1
B
2
B
1
2
2
1
2
W-L
2 AM1 ACC 3
2
5
B-L(*1) W (*2)
R
2
R
2
1
Y
R
7 AM2
ST2 8
2
IC4
B-Y
B
J3
W-B
4
EA2
2
STA Relay
3
2
Battery
2
AM2
2
Y-G
2
J/C
G
B-Y
G
J35
J/C
B
J3
1
S3
1
S2
Starter
W-B
*1: Cold Area Spec.
EB
*2: Except Cold Area Spec.
G032693E01
ES–272
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• The following troubleshooting flowchart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If
the engine will not crank, proceed to the problem symptoms table (See page ES-21).
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STARTER SIGNAL)
ES
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / STARTER SIG.
(d) Check the value displayed on the tester when the
ignition switch is turned on and START positions.
OK
Ignition Switch Positions
STARTER SIG
ON
OFF
START
ON
OK
REPLACE ECM
NG
2
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Inspect the Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch.
(1) Disconnect the P1 PNP switch connector.
(2) Measure the resistance when the transmission gear
selector lever is moved to each position.
Standard resistance
Component Side:
P1
Gear Selector Lever
Positions
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
P
2 - 6, 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
PNP Switch
A093221E13
R
1-2
Below 1 Ω
N
2 - 9, 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
D
2-7
Below 1 Ω
2
2-3
Below 1 Ω
L
2-8
Below 1 Ω
(3) Reconnect the PNP switch connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
ES–273
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STARTER SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / STARTER SIG.
(d) Check the value displayed on the tester when the
ignition switch is turned on and START positions.
OK
Ignition Switch Positions
STARTER SIG
ON
OFF
START
ON
OK
ES
SYSTEM OK
NG
4
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Component
Side:
Ignition Switch
I18
(a) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(b) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance
Ignition Switch
Positions
Tester Conditions
Specified Condition
LOCK
All Terminals
10 kΩ or higher
ACC
2-4
Below 1 Ω
ON
1-2, 1-4, 5-6
Below 1 Ω
START
1-3, 1-4, 3-4, 5-6, 5-7, 6-7
Below 1 Ω
A056879E39
(c) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
NG
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STARTER SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
STARTER SIG.
(d) Check the value displayed on the tester when the
ignition switch is turned on and START positions.
OK
Ignition Switch Positions
STARTER SIG
ON
OFF
START
ON
OK
SYSTEM OK
ES–274
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ES
ES–275
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0630
VIN not Programmed or Mismatch - ECM / PCM
DESCRIPTION
DTC P0630 is set when the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is not stored in the Engine Control Module
(ECM) or the input VIN is not accurate. Input the VIN with the intelligent tester.
DTC No.
P0630
DTC Detection Conditions
•
•
VIN not stored in ECM
Input VIN in ECM not accurate
Trouble Areas
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0630: VIN not programmed
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Ignition switch
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
VIN code
Not programmed
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VIN code
Programmed
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ CURRENT DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0630
A
P0630 and other DTCs
B
If any DTCs other than P0630 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
ES–276
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NOTICE:
If P0630 is set, the VIN must be input to the ECM
using the intelligent tester. However, all DTCs are
cleared automatically by the tester when inputting
the VIN. If DTCs other than P0630 are set, check
them first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
INPUT VIN WITH INTELLIGENT TESTER
ES
HINT:
Refer to "REGISTRATION" (See page ES-9).
NEXT
3
READ CURRENT DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTC again.
Result:
DTC is not output (P0630).
NG
OK
END
REPLACE ECM
ES–277
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0657
Actuator Supply Voltage Circuit / Open
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the output voltage to the throttle actuator. This self-check ensures that the ECM
functioning properly. The output voltage usually is 0 V when the ignition switch is turned OFF. If the output
voltage is higher than 7 volts when the ignition switch is turned OFF, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and
set a DTC when the ignition switch is turned ON.
DTC
P0657
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Throttle actuator power supply error
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES Related DTCs
ES
None
Required sensors / components (main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (sub)
Throttle actuator
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 1 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Ignition switch
From ON to OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
7 V or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the battery negative terminal and wait for 1
minute.
(d) Connect the battery terminal.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON for 10 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(g) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(h) Check DTC.
OK:
P0657 is not present.
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–278
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2102
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit Low
DTC
P2103
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
ES
The throttle actuator is operated by the ECM and opens and closes the throttle valve using gears.
The opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the Throttle Position (TP) sensor, which is mounted
on the throttle body. The TP sensor provides feedback to the ECM. This feedback allows the ECM to
appropriately control the throttle actuator and monitor the throttle opening angle as the ECM responds to
driver inputs.
HINT:
This ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P2102
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 seconds (1 trip
detection logic):
(a) Throttle actuator duty ratio 80% or more
(b) Throttle actuator current is 0.5 A or less
•
•
•
Open in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
ECM
P2103
Either of following conditions met:
• Hybrid IC diagnosis signal fail
• Hybrid IC current limiter port fail
•
•
•
•
•
Short in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
Throttle valve
Throttle body
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the electrical current through the electronic actuator, and detects malfunctions and
open circuits in the throttle actuator based on this value. If the current is outside the standard range, the
ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the throttle actuator. In addition, if the throttle valve does
not function properly (for example, stuck on), the ECM determines that there is a malfunction. The ECM
then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the electrical current is more than 10 A, or less than 0.5 A and the throttle actuator duty ratio
exceeds 80%, the ECM interprets this as the current being outside the standard range, and illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set when the engine is quickly revved to a high
rpm several times after the engine has idled for 5 seconds after engine start.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2102: Throttle actuator control motor current (low current)
P2103: Throttle actuator control motor current (high current)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Throttle actuator (throttle body)
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
P2102: 2 seconds
P2103: 0.6 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–279
P2102:
Throttle motor
ON
Duty-cycle ratio to open throttle actuator
80 % or more
Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
Current motor current - Motor current at 0.016 sec.
before
Less than 0.2 A
P2103:
Throttle motor
ON
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
2. Throttle actuator power
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2102:
Throttle actuator current
Less than 0.5 A (when motor drive duty 80 % or more)
P2103:
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Hybrid IC diagnosis signal
Fail
2. Hybrid IC current limiter port
Fail
FAIL-SAFE
When either of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 6° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned to off.
ES
ES–280
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T2
Throttle Control Motor
(Built in Throttle w/ Motor Body)
ECM
(Shielded)
M+ 2
P
5
M+
E4
1
L
4
ME4
M-
ES
17
E4
GE01
A087825E09
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
• The throttle actuator current (THROTTLE MOT) and the throttle actuator duty ratio (THROTTLE OPN /
THROTTLE CLS) can be read using the intelligent tester. However the ECM shuts off the throttle
actuator current when the ETCS malfunctions.
1
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY (RESISTANCE OF THROTTLE
CONTROL MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle with motor body connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
throttle control motor.
Standard resistance
Component Side:
T2
Throttle with Motor Body Assembly
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
M+ (T2-2) - M- (T2-1)
0.3 to 100 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the throttle with motor body connector.
M+
MA059778E38
OK
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
ES–281
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side:
Throttle with Motor Body Connector
T2
1
M-
M+
2
3
4
5
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle with motor body connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
6
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
M+ (T2-2) - M+ (E4-5)
Below 1 Ω
M- (T2-1) - M- (E4-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Front View
ECM:
E4
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
M+ (T2-2) or M+ (E4-5) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M- (T2-1) or M- (E4-4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the throttle with motor body connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
M+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
MA114631E03
OK
3
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Check for foreign objects between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK:
Normal
NG
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT AND CLEAN
THROTTLE BODY
OK
4
INSPECT THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Check if the throttle valve opens and closes smoothly.
OK:
The throttle valve opens and closes smoothly.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–282
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2111
Throttle Actuator Control System - Stuck Open
DTC
P2112
Throttle Actuator Control System - Stuck
Closed
DESCRIPTION
ES
The throttle actuator is operated by the ECM, and opens and closes the throttle valve using gears. The
opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the Throttle Position (TP) sensor, which is mounted on
the throttle body. The TP sensor provides feedback to the ECM in order that it can control the throttle
actuator, and the throttle valve, appropriately in response to driver inputs.
HINT:
This ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P2111
ECM signals throttle actuator to close, but stuck (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
•
Throttle actuator
Throttle body
Throttle valve
P2112
ECM signals throttle actuator to open, but stuck (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
•
Throttle actuator
Throttle body
Throttle valve
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the ETCS when the throttle valve remains at the fixed
angle despite a high drive current from the ECM. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set when the accelerator pedal is fully depressed
and released quickly (to fully open and close the throttle valve) after the engine is next started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2111: Throttle actuator stuck open
P2112: Throttle actuator stuck closed
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Throttle actuator (throttle body)
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
P2111:
System guard*
ON
Throttle actuator current
2 A or more
Duty cycle to close throttle
80 % or more
P2112:
System guard*
ON
Throttle actuator current
2 A or more
Duty cycle to open throttle
80 % or more
ES–283
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
*: System guard is ON when the following conditions
are met
-
Throttle actuator
ON
Throttle actuator duty calculation
Executing
Throttle position sensor
Fail determined
Throttle actuator current-cut operation
Not executing
Throttle actuator power supply
4 V or more
Throttle actuator
Fail determined
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2111:
TP sensor voltage change for 0.016 seconds
Less than 0.1 V for 0.5 seconds or more
ES
P2112:
TP sensor voltage change for 0.016 seconds
Less than 0.1 V for 0.5 seconds or more
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 6° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned off.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 (See page ES-274).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2111 OR P2112)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2111 or P2112
A
P2111 or P2112 and other DTCs
B
ES–284
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2111 or P2112 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY (VISUALLY CHECK THROTTLE
VALVE)
(a) Check for contamination between the throttle valve and
the housing. If necessary, clean the throttle body. And
check that the throttle valve moves smoothly.
OK:
Throttle valve is not contaminated with foreign
objects and moves smoothly.
ES
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2111 OR P2112)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine, and fully depress and release the
accelerator pedal quickly (to fully open and close the
throttle valve).
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No DTC
A
P2111 or P2112
B
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–285
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Current Range
/ Performance
P2118
DESCRIPTION
The ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) has a dedicated power supply circuit. The voltage (+BM)
is monitored and when it is low (less than 4 V), the ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the
ETCS and cuts off the current to the throttle actuator.
When the voltage becomes unstable, the ETCS itself becomes unstable. For this reason, when the
voltage is low, the current to the throttle actuator is cut. If repairs are made and the system returns to
normal, turn the ignition switch off. The ECM then allows the current to flow to the throttle actuator so that
it can be restarted.
HINT:
The ETCS does not use a throttle cable.
ECM
ETCS Fuse
From
Battery
+BM
Throttle Control Motor
+M
Motor Control
Circuit
-M
ME01
A085832E19
DTC No.
P2118
DTC Detection Conditions
Open in ETCS power source (+BM) circuit (1 trip
detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ETCS fuse
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the battery supply voltage applied to the throttle actuator.
When the power supply voltage (+BM) drops below 4 V for 0.8 seconds or more, the ECM interprets this
as an open in the power supply circuit (+BM). The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 5 seconds after the engine is next started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2118: Throttle actuator motor power supply line range check (Low voltage)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Throttle actuator, throttle valve, ETCS fuse
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.8 seconds
ES
ES–286
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Electronic throttle actuator power
ON
Battery voltage
More than 8 V
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ES
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
Less than 4 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
11 to 14 V
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 6° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed. If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned off.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
GR
13
IC4
GR
7
E8
+BM
2
2
ETCS
Engine Room R/B
1
2
B
Battery
A074728E03
ES–287
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK FUSE (ETCS FUSE)
Engine
Room R/B:
ETCS Fuse
(a) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Check the ETCS fuse resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
NG
CHECK FOR SHORTS IN ALL HARNESSES
AND CONNECTORS CONNECTED TO FUSE
AND REPLACE FUSE
A072882E01
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (+BM VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E6
and E8 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E6
E8
OK
E1 (-)
+BM (+)
A131509E47
NG
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+BM (E8-7) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–288
3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - ETCS FUSE, ETCS FUSE - BATTERY)
Engine Room R/B:
ETCS Fuse
(a) Check the harness and connector between the ETCS
fuse and ECM.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
ETCS fuse (2) - +BM (E8-7)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
ETCS fuse (2) or +BM (E8-7) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ECM:
E8
+BM
(4) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and connector between the ETCS
fuse and positive battery cable.
(1) Disconnect the negative battery cable.
(2) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
A138725E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Positive battery cable - ETCS fuse (1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Positive battery cable or ETCS fuse (1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(3) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
(4) Reconnect the negative battery cable.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–289
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Throttle Actuator Control Throttle Body Range /
Performance
P2119
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) is composed of the throttle actuator, Throttle Position (TP)
sensor, Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor, and ECM. The ECM operates the throttle actuator to
regulate the throttle valve in response to driver inputs. The TP sensor detects the opening angle of the
throttle valve, and provides the ECM with feedback so that the throttle valve can be appropriately
controlled by the ECM.
DTC No.
P2119
DTC Detection Conditions
Throttle valve opening angle continues to vary greatly
from target opening angle (1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
ETCS
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the actual opening angle of the throttle valve from the TP sensor signal. The actual
opening angle is compared to the target opening angle commanded by the ECM. If the difference
between these two values is outside the standard range, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the
ETCS. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, the DTC is set when the accelerator pedal is quickly
released (to close the throttle valve) after the engine speed reaches 5,000 rpm by the accelerator pedal
being fully depressed (fully open the throttle valve).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2119: Electronic throttle control system failure
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Throttle actuator (throttle body)
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
System guard*
ON
*System guard is ON when following conditions are set:
-
Throttle actuator
ON
Throttle actuator duty calculation
Executing
Throttle position sensor
Fail determined
Throttle actuator current-cut operation
Not executing
Throttle actuator power supply
4 V or more
Throttle actuator
Fail determined
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is set:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Commanded closed throttle position - current closed
throttle position
0.3 V or more for 1 second
2. Commanded open throttle position - current open
throttle position
0.3 V or more for 0.6 second
ES
ES–290
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 6° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed. If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned off.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 (See page ES-274).
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2119)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2119
A
P2119 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2119 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2119)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (Procedure
"A").
(b) Turn the ignition switch on (Procedure "B").
(c) Turn the tester on (Procedure "C").
(d) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31) (Procedure "D").
(e) Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds (Procedure "E").
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–291
CAUTION:
Exercise extreme care and take precautions at
procedure "F" and "G" below. Failure to do so may
result in the vehicle unexpectedly rolling away.
(f) Securely apply the parking brake and move the gear
selector lever to the D position (Procedure "F").
(g) While depressing the brake pedal securely, fully depress
the accelerator pedal for 5 seconds (Procedure "G").
(h) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
CURRENT CODES (Procedure "H").
(i) Read DTCs (Procedure "I").
HINT:
The voltage output of the throttle position sensor can be
checked during procedure "G" using the intelligent tester.
Variations in the voltage output indicate that the throttle
actuator is in operation. To check the voltage output
using the intelligent tester, select the following menu
items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST /
PRIMARY / THROTTLE POS #1.
OK:
No DTC output.
NG
OK
NORMAL
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–25
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
When a malfunction is not confirmed by a DTC (Diagnostic
Trouble Code) check and the cause of problem cannot be
identified through a basic inspection, troubleshoot according
to the priority order indicated in the table below.
SFI SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
1. Immobilizer system
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
Engine cranks normally but difficult to start
Difficult to start with cold engine
Difficult to start with warm engine
High engine idling speed (Poor idling)
Low engine idling speed (Poor idling)
ST-13
3. Starter (for Cold Area)
ST-30
ST-37
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-372
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
3. VC output circuit
ES-377
4. ECM
ES-434
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
2. Compression
EM-2
1. Starter signal circuit
ES-264
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
3. Spark plug
IG-1
4. Ignition system
ES-196
5. Injector
ES-165
1. Starter signal circuit
ES-264
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
3. Spark plug
IG-1
4. Ignition system
ES-196
5. Injector
ES-165
1. A/C signal circuit (compressor circuit)
AC-82
2. ECM power source circuit
ES-372
3. Electronic throttle control system
ES-112
4. Air induction system
-
5. PCV hose
-
1. A/C signal circuit (compressor circuit)
AC-82
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
3. Electronic throttle control system
ES-112
4. Air induction system
5. PCV hose
1. Compression
Rough idling (Poor idling)
EI-2
2. Starter (for Standard)
4. STARTER relay
No initial combustion (Does not start)
See page
EM-2
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
3. Electronic throttle control system
ES-112
4. Air induction system
-
5. PCV hose
-
ES
ES–26
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
ES-372
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
3. Spark plug
Hunting (Poor idling)
4. Ignition system
ES-196
ES-165
6. Electronic throttle control system
ES-112
8. PCV hose
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES
Engine stalls soon after starting
Engine stalls during A/C operation
Unable/difficult to refuel
ES-381
2. A/T faulty (A750F)
AT-9
2. A/T faulty (A750E)
AT-9
3. Spark plug
4. Ignition system
Surging (Poor driveability)
IG-1
5. Injector
7. Air induction system
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (Poor driveability)
See page
1. ECM power source circuit
IG-1
ES-196
5. Injector
ES-165
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
2. Spark plug
3. Ignition system
IG-1
ES-196
4. Injector
ES-165
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-381
2. Spark plug
IG-1
3. Ignition system
ES-196
4. Injector
ES-165
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
AC-82
2. ECM
ES-434
Refueling valve (canister)
-
ES–292
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit
DTC
P2122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P2123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2125
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit
DTC
P2127
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P2128
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2138
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D" /
"E" Voltage Correlation
HINT:
These DTCs relate to the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
This ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) does not use a throttle cable.
The Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket and has 2
sensor circuits: VPA (main) and VPA2 (sub). This sensor is a non-contact type, and uses Hall-effect
elements, in order to yield accurate signals, even in extreme driving conditions, such as at high speeds as
well as very low speeds. The voltage, which is applied to terminals VPA and VPA2 of the ECM, varies
between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the operating angle of the accelerator pedal (throttle valve). A signal
from VPA indicates the actual accelerator pedal opening angle (throttle valve opening angle) and is used
for engine control. A signal from VPA2 conveys the status of the VPA circuit and is used to check the APP
sensor itself.
The ECM monitors the actual accelerator pedal opening angle (throttle valve opening angle) through the
signals from VPA and VPA2, and controls the throttle actuator according to these signals.
ES–293
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Output Voltage (V)
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
*1
*2
ECM
5
Magnet
IC No. 1
VPA
3.4 to 5.0
2.6 to 4.5
EPA
ES
1.6
VCPA
0.8
VPA2
EPA2
IC No. 2
25
0
VCP2
Usable Range
Accelerator Pedal Turning Angle (deg)
Magnet
*1: Accelerator Pedal Fully Released
*2: Accelerator Pedal Fully Depressed
A019803E29
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P2120
VPA fluctuates rapidly beyond upper and lower
malfunction thresholds for 0.5 seconds or more (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor
ECM
P2122
VPA 0.4 V or less for 0.5 seconds or more when
accelerator pedal is fully released (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in VCP1 circuit
Open or ground short in VPA circuit
ECM
P2123
VPA 4.8 V or more for 2.0 seconds or more (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in EPA circuit
ECM
P2125
VPA2 fluctuates rapidly beyond upper and lower
malfunction thresholds for 0.5 seconds or more (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
APP sensor
ECM
P2127
VPA2 is 1.2 V or less for 0.5 seconds or more when
accelerator pedal is fully released (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in VCP2 circuit
Open or ground short in VPA2 circuit
ECM
P2128
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 seconds or more
(1 trip detection logic):
(a) VPA2 is 4.8 V or more
(b) VPA between 0.4 V and 3.45 V
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in EPA2 circuit
ECM
ES–294
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P2138
Condition (a) or (b) continues for 2.0 seconds or more
(1 trip detection logic):
(a) Difference between VPA and VPA2 is 0.02 V or less
(b) VPA is 0.4 V or less and VPA2 is 1.2 V or less
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Short between VPA and VPA2 circuits
APP sensor
ECM
HINT:
When any of these DTCs are set, check the APP sensor voltage by selecting the following menu items on
the intelligent tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / ACCEL POS #1 and ACCEL
POS #2.
Trouble Areas
ES
ACCEL POS #1 When
AP Released
ACCEL POS #2 When
AP Released
ACCEL POS #1 When
AP Depressed
ACCEL POS #2 When
AP Depressed
VCP circuit open
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
Open or ground short in VPA circuit
0 to 0.2 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
0 to 0.2 V
3.4 to 5.0 V
Open or ground short in VPA2 circuit
0.5 to 1.1 V
0 to 0.2 V
2.6 to 4.5 V
0 to 0.2 V
EPA circuit open
4.5 to 5.0 V
4.5 to 5.0 V
4.5 to 5.0 V
4.5 to 5.0 V
Normal condition
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.0 V
HINT:
• Accelerator pedal positions are expressed as voltages.
• AP denotes for Accelerator Pedal.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When either of the voltage outputs of VPA or VPA2 deviates from the standard range, or the difference
between the voltage outputs of the 2 sensor circuits is less than the threshold, the ECM determines that
there is a malfunction in the APP sensor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the voltage output of VPA drops below 0.2 V for more than 0.5 seconds when the accelerator pedal
is fully depressed, DTC P2122 is set.
If the malfunction is not repaired successfully, a DTC is set 2 seconds after the engine is next started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2120: Accelerator position sensor 1 (VPA) range check (Fluttering)
P2122: Accelerator position sensor 1 (VPA) range check (Low voltage)
P2123: Accelerator position sensor 1 (VPA) range check (High voltage)
P2125: Accelerator position sensor 2 (VPA2) range check (Fluttering)
P2127: Accelerator position sensor 2 (VPA2) range check (Low voltage)
P2128: Accelerator position sensor 2 (VPA2) range check (High voltage)
P2138: Accelerator position sensor correlation range check
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Accelerator position sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds: P2120, P2122, P2125 and P2127
2.0 seconds: P2123, P2128 and P2138
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Ignition switch
ON
Throttle control motor power
ON
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–295
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2120:
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA voltage when VPA2 is 0.04 V or more
0.4 V or less
2. VPA voltage
4.8 or more
P2122:
VPA1 voltage when VPA2 is 0.04 V or more
0.4 V or less
P2123:
VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2125:
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA2 voltage when VPA is 0.04 V or more
1.2 V or less
2. VPA2 voltage when VPA is 0.4 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2127:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.04 V or more
1.2 V or less
P2128:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.4 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2138:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Difference between VPA 1 and VPA2 voltage
0.02 V or less
2. Both of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a) and (b)
(a) VPA1 voltage
0.4 V or less
(b) VPA2 voltage
1.2 V or less
FAIL-SAFE
When any of DTCs P2120, P2121, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and P2138 are set, the ECM
enters fail-safe mode. If either of the 2 sensor circuit malfunctions, the ECM uses the remaining circuit to
calculate the accelerator pedal position to allow the vehicle to continue driving. If both of the circuits
malfunction, the ECM regards the accelerator pedal as being released. As a result, the throttle valve is
closed and the engine idles.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is turned off.
ES
ES–296
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A24
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
6
W-R
34
IC4
W-R
18 VPA
E8
5
LG-B
29
IC4
LG-B
20
E8
VCP1 4
B-Y
26
IC4
B-Y
26
E8
3
R-B
31
IC4
R-B
19 VPA2
E8
2
V-W
8
IC3
V-W
21
E8
W-L
9
IC3
W-L
VPA1
EP1
ES
ECM
VPA2
EP2
VCP2
1
EPA
VCPA
EPA2
27
VCP2
E8
A074729E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCEL POS #1 AND ACCEL POS #2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester ON.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / ACCEL POS #1
and ACCEL POS #2.
(d) Read the values displayed on the tester.
Standard voltage
Depressed
Released
Accelerator Pedal
Operations
ACCEL POS #1 (AP#1)
ACCEL POS #2 (AP#2)
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.0 V
FI07052E14
OK
NG
Go to step 5
ES–297
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR ECM)
Wire Harness Side:
VPA2
VCPA
EPA
EPA2
VCP2
VPA
1
A24
2
3
4
5
(a) Disconnect the A24 Accelerator Pedal Position (APP)
sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
6
Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor Connector
ECM:
EPA
VPA2
E8
VPA
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VPA (A24-6) - VPA (E8-18)
Below 1 Ω
EPA (A24-5) - EPA (E8-20)
Below 1 Ω
VCPA (A24-4) - VCPA (E8-26)
Below 1 Ω
VPA2 (A24-3) - VPA2 (E8-19)
Below 1 Ω
EPA2 (A24-2) - EPA2 (E8-21)
Below 1 Ω
VCP2 (A24-1) - VCP2 (E8-27)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
EPA2
VCP2
VCPA
A114633E03
Specified Conditions
VPA (A24-6) or VPA (E8-18) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EPA (A24-5) or EPA (E8-20) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VCPA (A24-4) or VCPA (E8-26) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VPA2 (A24-3) or VPA2 (E8-19) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EPA2 (A24-2) or EPA2 (E8-21) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VCP2 (A24-1) or VCP2 (E8-27) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the APP sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–298
3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM (VCPA AND VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the A24 APP sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E8
ECM connector.
Standard voltage
A24
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Connector
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VCPA (E8-26) - EPA (E8-20)
4.5 to 5.0 V
VCP2 (E8-27) - EPA2 (E8-21)
4.5 to 5.0 V
(d) Reconnect the APP sensor connector.
NG
ECM:
EPA2 (-)
REPLACE ECM
E8
EPA (-)
VCPA (+)
VCP2 (+)
A114634E03
OK
4
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the accelerator pedal rod assembly (See page
ES-436).
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine.
Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
CURRENT CODES.
(g) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and/or P2138
A
No output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–299
A
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–300
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Range / Performance
P2121
HINT:
This DTC relates to the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2120 (See page ES-286).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
P2121
Difference between VPA and VPA2 is less than 0.4 V, or
more than 1.2 V for 0.5 second (1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
APP sensor
ECM
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The accelerator pedal position sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket. The accelerator pedal
position sensor has 2 sensor elements and 2 signal outputs: VPA1 and VPA2. VPA1 is used to detect the
actual accelerator pedal angle (used for engine control) and VPA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VPA1.
When the difference between the voltage outputs of VPA1 and VPA2 deviates from the standard, the ECM
concludes the accelerator pedal position sensor has a malfunction. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC
is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2121: Accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor (rationality)
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
Accelerator position sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Ignition switch
ON
2. Throttle actuator power
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between VPA1 voltage (learned value) and
VPA2 voltage (learned value)
Less than 0.4 V, or more than 1.2 V
FAIL-SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has 2 (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in
either of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the 2 sensor
circuits and switches to limp mode. In limp mode, the functioning circuit is used to calculate the
accelerator pedal opening angle to allow the vehicle to continue driving. If both circuits malfunction, the
ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed. In this case, the throttle valve
will remain closed as if the engine is idling.
ES–301
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned off, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system returns to a normal condition.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2120 (See page ES-290).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCEL POS #1 AND ACCEL POS #2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / ACCEL POS #1
and ACCEL POS #2.
(d) Read the values displayed on the tester.
Standard voltage
Depressed
Released
Accelerator Pedal
Operations
ACCEL POS #1 (AP#1)
ACCEL POS #2 (AP#2)
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.0 V
FI07052E14
OK
NG
Go to step 4
ES
ES–302
2
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR ECM)
Wire Harness Side:
VPA2
VCP2
EP1
VPA1
1
ES
A24
VCP1
EP2
2
3
4
5
(a) Disconnect the A24 Accelerator Pedal Position (APP)
sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
6
Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor Connector
ECM:
EPA
VPA2
E8
VPA
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VPA1 (A24-6) - VPA (E8-18)
Below 1 Ω
EP1 (A24-5) - EPA (E8-20)
Below 1 Ω
VCP1(A24-4) - VCPA (E8-26)
Below 1 Ω
VPA2 (A24-3) - VPA2 (E8-19)
Below 1 Ω
EP2 (A24-2) - EPA2 (E8-21)
Below 1 Ω
VCP2 (A24-1) - VCP2 (E8-27)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
EPA2
VCP2
VCPA
Specified Conditions
VPA1 (A24-6) or VPA (E8-18) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EP1 (A24-5) or EPA (A24E8-20) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VCP1 (A24-4) or VCPA (E8-26) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VPA2 (A24-3) or VPA2 (E8-19) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A114633E04
EP2 (A24-2) or EPA2 (E84-21) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VCP2 (A24-1) or VCP2 (E8-27) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the APP sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the accelerator pedal rod assembly (See page
ES-436).
NEXT
4
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine.
Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
CURRENT CODES.
(g) Read DTCs.
ES–303
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2121
A
No output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–406
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ES
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
9.8 (100, 7)
TERMINAL CAP
43 (438, 32)
GENERATOR WIRE
GENERATOR
CONNECTOR
43 (438, 32)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
WIRE HARNESS CLAMP BRACKET
25 (255, 18)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
COOLER COMPRESSOR CONNECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119918E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–407
ES
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
10 (102, 7)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119792E01
ES–304
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2195
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Lean (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2196
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Rich (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2197
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Lean (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2198
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Rich (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
HINT:
• Although the DTC titles say oxygen sensor, these DTCs relate to the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted in front of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and
located near the engine assembly.
DESCRIPTION
The A/F sensor generates a voltage* that corresponds to the actual air-fuel ratio. This sensor voltage is
used to provide the ECM with feedback so that it can control the air-fuel ratio. The ECM determines the
deviation from the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio level, and regulates the fuel injection time. If the A/F sensor
malfunctions, the ECM is unable to control the air-fuel ratio accurately.
The A/F sensor is the planar type and is integrated with the heater, which heats the solid electrolyte
(zirconia element). This heater is controlled by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the exhaust
gas temperature is low), a current flows into the heater to heat the sensor, in order to facilitate accurate
oxygen concentration detection. In addition, the sensor and heater portions are narrower than the
conventional type. The heat generated by the heater is conducted to the solid electrolyte though the
alumina, therefore the sensor activation is accelerated.
In order to obtain a high purification rate of the carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and nitrogen
oxide (NOx) components in the exhaust gas, a TWC is used. For the most efficient use of the TWC, the
air-fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric level.
*: Value changes inside the ECM. Since the A/F sensor is the current output element, a current is
converted to a voltage inside the ECM. Any measurements taken at the A/F sensor or ECM connectors
will show a constant voltage.
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Alumina
Heater
Platinum Electrode
Cover
Element
Exhaust Gas
A
A
Atmospheric Air
A-A Cross Section
Air-fuel Ratio
A073819E03
ES–305
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
•
P2195
P2197
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor voltage is more than 3.8
V
(b) Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor voltage is 0.15 V or
more
P2195
P2197
While fuel-cut operation is performed (during vehicle
deceleration), air-furl ratio (A/F) sensor current is 3.6
mA or more for 3 seconds
P2196
P2198
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) A/F sensor voltage is less than 2.8 V
(b) HO2 sensor voltage is less than 0.6 V
P2196
P2198
While fuel-cut operation is performed (during vehicle
deceleration), air-furl ratio (A/F) sensor current less
than 1.4 mA for 3 seconds (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) heater
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
•
•
A/F sensor
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) heater
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
•
•
A/F sensor
ECM
HINT:
• DTCs P2195 and P2196 means malfunctions related to bank 1 A/F sensor circuit.
• DTCs P2197 and P2198 means malfunctions related to bank 2 A/F sensor circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 2.
• When any of these DTCs are set, check the A/F sensor voltage output by selecting the following menu
items on the intelligent tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBDII / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / AFS B1S1.
• Short-term fuel trim values can also be read using the intelligent tester.
• The ECM regulates the voltage at the A1A+, A2A+, A1A- and A2A- terminals of the ECM at a constant
level. Therefore, the A/F sensor voltage output cannot be confirmed without using the intelligent tester.
• If a A/F sensor malfunction is detected, the ECM sets a DTC.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Sensor voltage detection monitor
Under the air-fuel ratio feedback control, if the A/F sensor voltage output indicates rich or lean for a certain
period of time, the ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the A/F sensor. The ECM illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
Example:
If the A/F sensor voltage output is less than 2.8 V (very rich condition) for 10 seconds, despite the HO2
sensor voltage output being less than 0.85 V, the ECM sets DTC P2196. Alternatively, if the A/F sensor
voltage output is more than 3.8 V (very lean condition) for 10 seconds, despite the HO2 sensor voltage
output being 0.15 V or more, DTC P2195 is set.
Sensor current detection monitor
A rich air-fuel mixture causes a low air-fuel ratio sensor current, and a lean air-fuel mixture causes a high
air-fuel ratio sensor current. Therefore, the sensor output becomes high during acceleration, and the
sensor becomes low during deceleration with the throttle valve fully closed. The ECM monitors the air-fuel
ratio sensor current during fuel-cut and detects an unusual current value.
If the cumulative time the sensor output is 3.6mAor more (P2195: high-side stuck) or 1.4 mA or less
(P2196: low-side stuck) exceeds more than 3 seconds, the ECM interprets a malfunction in the air-fuel
ratio sensor and sets a DTC.
ES
ES–306
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Air-fuel Ratio Sensor Current Monitor:
Fuel-Cut
Cumulative Time “t” = t1 + t2 = 3 seconds or more
ON
OFF
Delay
Delay
Delay
(3 seconds)
(3 seconds)
(3 seconds)
Sensor Current (mA)
High Side Threshold
ES
Low Side Threshold
3 seconds or more
Normal Sensor Output
t1
t2
Abnormal Sensor Output
Time
G034989E04
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2195: A/F sensor (Bank 1) signal stuck lean
P2196: A/F sensor (Bank 1) signal stuck rich
P2197: A/F sensor (Bank 2) signal stuck lean
P2198: A/F sensor (Bank 2) signal stuck rich
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
HO2 sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds: A/F sensor signal stuck lean/rich
3 seconds: A/F sensor current (high/low side)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F Sensor heater Sensor 1), P0037, P0038, P0057,
P0058 (O2 Sensor heater Sensor 2), P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF Sensor),
P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT Sensor), P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT Sensor),
P0120, P0121, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223, P2135 (TP Sensor), P0125
(Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop), P0136, P0156 (O2 Sensor 2), P0171, P0172
(Fuel System), P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306 (Misfire),
P0335 (CKP Sensor), P0340 (CMP Sensor), P0450, P0451, P0452, P0453, P0455,
P0456 (EVAP System), P0500 (VSS)
P2195, P2197 (A/F sensor signal stuck lean):
Duration while all of the following conditions met
2 seconds or more
Rear HO2S voltage
0.15 V or more
Time after engine start
30 seconds or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
Engine
Running
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–307
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor signal stuck rich):
Duration while all of the following conditions met
2 seconds or more
Rear HO2S voltage
Less than 0.6 V
Time after engine start
30 seconds or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
Engine
Running
P2195, P2197 (A/F sensor signal (High side)):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or higher
A/F sensor status
Activated
Continuous time of fuel-cut
3 to 10 seconds.
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor signal (Low side)):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or higher
A/F sensor status
Activated
Continuous time of fuel-cut
3 to 10 seconds.
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2195, P2197 (A/F sensor signal stuck lean):
A/F sensor voltage
More than 3.8 V for 10 seconds
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor signal stuck rich):
A/F sensor voltage
Less than 2.8 V
P2195, P2197 (A/F sensor signal (High side)):
A/F sensor current
3.6 mA or more for 10 seconds
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor signal (Low side)):
A/F sensor current
Less than 1.4 mA
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES
ES–308
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A12
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
W
W-B
2
ECM
2
3
A/F
Heater
Relay
2
IC4 9
Engine
Room
R/B
W
5
1
2
2
HT 1
4 AF-
AF+ 3
R-L
(*1)
P
2 HA1A
E5
22 A1A+
E5
W
ES
L
IM1 4 J27
W J/C
A
B-R
2 +B
(*1)
A13
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A
B
30
A1AE5
A
W
Engine
Room
R/B
W-G
2
1
5
2
2
4 AF-
AF+ 3
35
IC4
W-B
B J2
2
2
2
A/F
HEATER
EFI
1
E5
HA2A
(*1)
Y
23
E5
A2A+
BR
31
E5
A2A-
W-G
8
E8
B-W
(*1)
EFI
Relay
2
L
B J2
E
MREL
E
J/C
J28
J/C
E
1
1
2
B
HT 1
2
3
2
2 +B
Engine
Room R/B
Battery
B J3
BR
*1: Shielded
W-B
EB
EE
G032689E02
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
This confirmation driving pattern is used in steps 4, 7, 17, and 21 of the following diagnostic
troubleshooting procedure when using the intelligent tester.
ES–309
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HO2S Monitor Drive Pattern
ECT: 75°C (167°F) or more
Vehicle Speed
Acceletor Pedal
Depressed
“G”
At Least 3 times
“I”
“J”
40 mph (64 km/h)
Acceletor
Pedal
Released
(Fuel-cut)
“K”
6 mph
(10 km/h)
“H”
“E”
Idling
Time
10 minutes
or more
Warning up
ES
10 seconds 4 seconds
or more
or more
G039659E01
Cumulative Detection Period “t” = t1 + t2 + t3
= 3 seconds or more
Driving Pattern Detail for “H” through “K”
“I”
Engine RPM
“J”
“K”
2,500 rpm
1,000 rpm
Idling
“H”
Idling
Delay
t2
t3
Time
4 seconds or more
Detection
Period t1 4 seconds or more
4 seconds or more
G034990E04
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (Procedure "A").
Turn the ignition switch on (Procedure "B").
Turn the tester on (Procedure "C").
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31) (Procedure "D").
Start the engine, and warm it up until the ECT reaches 75°C (167°F) or higher (Procedure "E").
Select the following menu items on the tester to check the fuel-cut status: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / USER DATA / FC IDLE (Procedure "F").
7. Drive the vehicle at between 40 mph (64 km/h) or more for at least 10 minutes. (Procedure "G").
8. Change the transmission to 2nd gear (Procedure "H").
9. Drive the vehicle at proper vehicle speed to perform fuel-cut operation (refer to the following HINT)
(Procedure "I").
HINT:
Fuel-cut is performed when the following conditions are met:
• Accelerator pedal is fully released.
• Engine speed is 2,500 rpm or more (fuel injection returns at 1,000 rpm).
10.Accelerate the vehicle to 30 mph (48 km/h) or more by depressing the accelerator pedal for at least 10
seconds (Procedure "J").
11.Soon after performing procedure "J" above, release the accelerator pedal for at least 4 seconds
without depressing the brake pedal, in order to execute fuel-cut control (Procedure "K").
12.Allow the vehicle to decelerate until the vehicle speed declines to less than 6 mph (10 km/h)
(Procedure "L").
ES–310
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
13.Repeat procedures from "H" through "K" above at least 3 times in one driving cycle (Procedure "M").
HINT:
Completion of all A/F sensor monitors is required to change the value in TEST RESULT.
CAUTION:
Strictly observe of posted speed limits, traffic laws, and road conditions when performing these
drive patterns.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using an intelligent
tester.
(a)Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b)Start the engine and turn the tester on.
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(d)Select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
(e)Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
(f) Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection
volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
ES–311
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
3
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air-fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
4
– Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check the graph of the voltage outputs
of both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
– To display the graph, select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II
/ ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2, and press the YES button and then the ENTER button. Then press the F4 button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at
the time of a malfunction.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a rich air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run rich.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a lean air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that
would cause the engine to run lean.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
A
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
A
GO TO DTC CHART
ES
ES–312
2
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Turn the tester on.
Warm up the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor at an engine
speed of 2,500 rpm for 90 seconds.
(e) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT /
MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 or AFS
B2S1 and ENGINE SPD.
(f) Check the A/F sensor voltage 3 times, when the engine
is in each of the following conditions:
(1) While idling (check for at least 30 seconds) (Step
(1))
(2) At an engine speed of approximately 2,500 rpm
(without any sudden changes in engine speed)
(Step (2))
(3) Raise the engine speed to 4,000 rpm and then
quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the
throttle valve is fully closed (Step (3)).
ES
Standard voltage
Conditions
A/F Sensor Voltage Variations
Steps (1) and (2)
Step (3)
Reference
Changes at approximately 3.3 V
3.1 to 3.5 V
Increases to 3.8 V or more
This occurs during engine deceleration
(when fuel-cut performed)
HINT:
For more information, see the diagrams below.
Malfunction Conditon:
Normal Conditon:
(3) Approximately
4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) idling
Engine
RPM
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) idling
(1) idling
Engine
RPM
“Condition (3)” 3.8 V or More
A/F Sensor
Voltage
A/F Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
“Condition (1), (2)” Change
at approximately 3.3 V
( ): Step No.
(1) idling
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
( ): Step No.
A072304E14
ES–313
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
• If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
approximately 3.3 V (see Malfunction Condition
diagram) under any conditions, including those
above, the A/F sensor may have an open circuit.
(This will also happen if the A/F sensor heater
has an open circuit.)
• If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
either approximately 3.8 V or more, or 2.8 V or
less (see Malfunction Condition diagram) under
any conditions, including those above, the A/F
sensor may have a short circuit.
• The ECM stops fuel injection (fuel cut) during
engine deceleration. This causes a lean
condition and results in a momentary increase in
the A/F sensor output voltage.
• The ECM must establish a closed throttle valve
position learning value to perform fuel cut. If the
battery terminal has been reconnected, the
vehicle must be driven over 10 mph (16 km/h) to
allow the ECM to learn the closed throttle valve
position.
• When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be
below 2.8 V during fuel enrichment. For the
vehicle, this translates to a sudden increase in
speed with the accelerator pedal fully depressed
when trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/F
sensor is functioning normally.
• The A/F sensor is a current output element;
therefore, the current is converted into a voltage
inside the ECM. Measuring the voltage at the
connectors of the A/F sensor or ECM will show a
constant voltage result.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
3
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
4
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
A
No output
B
ES
ES–314
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
Go to step 8
A
5
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
6
ES
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
7
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
B
B
REPLACE ECM
A
8
CONFIRM WHETHER VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
YES
DTC CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DIVING
PATTERN
ES–315
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
9
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
A12
Bank 1
+B
HT
+B
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
ES
Bank 2
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A13
Bank 2
Tester Connections
HT
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A126269E08
OK
10
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR HEATER RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F sensor heater relay from the engine
room R/B.
(b) Check the A/F sensor heater relay resistance.
Standard resistance
B016200
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the A/F sensor heater relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
HEATER RELAY
ES–316
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
11
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
A/F Sensor Connector
A12 Bank 1
+B
HT
1
2
3
4
AF+
AFFront View
ES
A13 Bank 2
HT
2
3
4
AF+
Specified Conditions
+B (A12-2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
+B (A13-2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch off.
(e) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the terminals of A/F
sensor connector and ECM connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
+B
1
Tester Connections
AF-
ECM:
E5
HA1A
A2A+
A2A-
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
Below 1 Ω
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A114635E02
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 1):
A/F Sensor Heater Relay
From
Battery
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B
A/F Heater Fuse
AFFrom EFI
Relay
Heater
Sensor
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
EFI No. 2
A1A-
Duty
Control
G035624E02
ES–317
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
12
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
13
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-4).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
14
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the injector injection (whether fuel volume is high
or low, and whether injection pattern is poor) (See page
FU-11).
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
OK
15
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
16
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
17
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRET CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
ES
ES–318
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
18
CONFIRM WHETHER VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
ES
YES
DTC CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–319
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2238
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2239
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2241
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2242
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2252
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2253
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2255
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2256
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
HINT:
• Although the DTC titles say oxygen sensor, these DTCs relate to the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted in front of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and
located near the engine assembly.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-298).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
•
P2238
P2241
•
Case 1:
Condition (a) or (b) continues for 5.0 seconds or
more (1 trip detection logic):
(a) AF+ voltage is 0.5 V or less
(b) (AF+) - (AF-) = 0.1 V or less
Case 2:
A/F sensor admittance: Less than 0.022 1/Ω (2 trip
detection logic)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P2239
P2242
AF+ voltage is more than 4.5 V for 5.0 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
ES
ES–320
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
•
P2252
P2255
AF- voltage is 0.5 V or less for 5.0 seconds or more (2
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
P2253
P2256
ES
AF- voltage is more than 4.5 V for 5.0 seconds or more
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor heater relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
HINT:
• DTC P2238, P2239, P2252 and P2253 means malfunction related to the bank 1 A/F sensor circuit.
• DTC P2241, P2242, P2255 and P2256 means malfunction related to the bank 2 A/F sensor circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 2.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor varies its output voltage in proportion to the air-fuel ratio. If the A/F sensor
impedance (alternating current resistance) or voltage output deviates greatly from the standard range, the
ECM determines that there is an open or short malfunction in the A/F sensor circuit.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) open circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2239: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and +B
P2241: A/F sensor (Bank 2) open circuit between AF+ and AFP2241: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2241: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2242: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and +B
P2252: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF- and GND
P2253: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF- and +B
P2255: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF- and GND
P2256: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF- and +B
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
ECT sensor, Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds: A/F sensor open circuit between AF+ and AF5 seconds: Others
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
P2238 and P2241 (open circuit between AF+ and AF-):
AF+ terminal voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
Difference between AF+ terminal and AF- terminal
voltages
0.1 to 0.8 V
ECT
5°C (41°F) or more
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Engine
Running
Fuel-cut
OFF
Time after fuel-cut OFF
5 seconds or more
A/F sensor heater
ON
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Time after ignition switch is OFF to ON
5 seconds or more
ES–321
Others:
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Time after ignition switch is OFF to ON
5 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2238, P2241 (Open circuit between AF+ and AF-):
A/F sensor admittance
Below 0.022 1/Ω
P2238, P2241 (Short circuit between AF+ and GND):
AF+ terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2238, P2241 (Short circuit between AF+ and AF-):
Difference between AF+ and AF- terminal voltages
0.1 V or less
P2239, P2242 (Short circuit between AF+ and +B):
AF+ terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
P2252, P2255 (Short circuit between AF- and GND):
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2253, P2256 (Short circuit between AF- and +B):
AF- terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-302).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
For use the intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
(a)Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b)Start the engine and turn the tester on.
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(d)Select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
(e)Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
ES
ES–322
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(f) Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection
volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
ES
NOTICE:
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
3
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air-fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
– Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check the graph of the voltage outputs
of both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
ES–323
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
– To display the graph, select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II
/ ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2, and press the YES button and then the ENTER button followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at
the time of a malfunction.
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
A12
Bank 1
+B
HT
+B
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT(1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
Bank 2
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A13
Bank 2
Tester Connections
HT
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A126269E08
OK
2
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR HEATER RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F sensor heater relay from the engine
room R/B.
(b) Check the A/F sensor heater relay resistance.
Standard resistance
B016200
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and
2)
(c) Reinstall the A/F sensor heater relay.
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
HEATER RELAY
ES
ES–324
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
A/F Sensor Connector
A12 Bank 1
HT
ES
+B
1
2
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3
4
+B (A12-2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
+B (A13-2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
AF+
AFFront View
A13 Bank 2
HA2A
AF+
(d) Turn the ignition switch off.
(e) Disconnect the B46 ECM connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the terminals of A/F
sensor connector and ECM connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
+B
1
2
3
4
AF-
Tester Connections
ECM:
E5
HA1A
A2A+
A2A-
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
Below 1 Ω
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A114635E04
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
ES–325
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 1):
A/F Sensor Heater Relay
From
Battery
From EFI
Relay
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B
A/F Heater Fuse
AF-
Heater
Sensor
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
EFI No. 2
A1A-
Duty
Control
ES
G035624E02
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–326
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2401
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detection
Pump Control Circuit Low
DTC
P2402
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detection
Pump Control Circuit High
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
Monitoring Items
Malfunction Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
•
ES
P2401
P2402
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
Vacuum pump stuck ON
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and
P2419 present when one of following
conditions met during key-off EVAP
monitor:
• EVAP pressure just after reference
pressure measurement greater than
-1 kPa-g (-7.5 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure less than -4.85
kPa-g (-36.4 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure greater than 1.057 kPa-g (-7.93 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure not saturated
• Reference pressure difference
between first and second 0.7 kPa-g
(5.25 mmHg-g) or more
HINT:
Typical example values
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Canister pump module
(Reference orifice,
leak detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet port
to canister pump
module, canister filter,
fuel tank vent hose)
ECM
While
ignition
switch off
2 trip
Canister pump module
(Reference orifice,
leak detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet port
to canister pump
module, canister filter,
fuel tank vent hose)
ECM
While
ignition
switch off
2 trip
*
: The threshold values vary according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described in the table above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg).
HINT:
The vacuum pump is built into the pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-346).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP System (See page ES-349).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours*1 after the ignition switch is turned off, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator
malfunctions based on the EVAP pressure.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–327
HINT:
*1: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) after 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
*2
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
-
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch
turned to OFF.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525
mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump
creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then
ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) is created in EVAP system, and EVAP
system pressure then measured.
Write down measured value as it will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels
EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*2
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV is opened and then EVAP system pressure is measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak pressure measurement, leak check is
performed by comparing first and second 0.02 inch leak pressure
standards.
If stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard, ECM determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure is measured and then monitoring result is
recorded by ECM.
-
ES
-
: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES–328
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation A:
Operation B, E:
Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
Purge VSV:
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF
OFF
(vent)
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Vacuum Pump: OFF
ES
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
Pump Module
ON (closed)
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
(closed)
ON
A096746E18
ES–329
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P2401: Vacuum pump stuck OFF
In operation B, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (a vacuum) through the 0.02 inch orifice.
The EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system pressure is then measured by the ECM, using the pressure
sensor, to determine the 0.02 inch leak pressure standard. If the pressure is higher than -1.2 kPa (-7.5
mmHg)*, or lower than -4.3 kPa (-32.25 mmHg)*, the ECM interprets this as the vacuum pump being
stuck OFF (not operating). The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*
: The thresholds vary according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Vacuum Pump Stuck OFF:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
Malfunction
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
B
C
10 seconds
60 seconds
With 15 minutes
D
E
60 seconds
10
seconds
F
G036777E07
ES
ES–330
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P2402: Vacuum pump stuck ON
In operation B, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (a vacuum) through the 0.02 inch orifice.
The EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system pressure is then measured by the ECM, using the pressure
sensor, to determine the 0.02 inch leak pressure standard. If the pressure is higher than -1.2 kPa (-7.5
mmHg)*, or lower than -4.3 kPa (-32.25 mmHg)*, the ECM interprets this as the vacuum pump being
stuck ON (remaining ON all the time). The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection
logic).
*: The thresholds vary according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Vacuum Pump Stuck ON:
ES
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
OK
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Malfunction
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
10 seconds
B
C
With 15 minutes
60 seconds
D
E
10
seconds
60 seconds
G036778E09
HINT:
The detection logic of DTCs P2401 and P2402 is the same because in both cases the 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard measured in operation B is compared to the atmospheric pressure registered in
operation A. The ECM calculates the difference between these pressures by deducting [the 0.02 inch
leak pressure standard] from [the stored atmospheric pressure], and uses this to monitor the EVAP
system pressure change.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2401: Vacuum pump stuck OFF
P2402: Vacuum pump stuck ON
Required Sensors / Components
Pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 2 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452,
P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 or 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
One of the following conditions is met
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. EVAP pressure just after reference pressure
measurement start
More than -1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg)
2. Reference pressure
Less than -1.85 kPa (-36.4 mmHg)
3. Reference pressure
-1.057 kPa (-7.93 mmHg) or more
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated within 60 seconds
5. Difference between first reference pressure and
second reference pressure
0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES–331
ES
ES–332
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2419
Evaporative Emission System Switching Valve
Control Circuit Low
DTC
P2420
Evaporative Emission System Switching Valve
Control Circuit High
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
Monitoring Items
ES
P2419
Vent valve stuck closed
Malfunction Detection Conditions
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and
P2419 present when one of following
conditions met during key-off EVAP
monitor:
• EVAP pressure just after reference
pressure measurement greater than
-1 kPa-g (-7.5 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure less than -4.85
kPa-g (-36.4 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure greater than 1.057 kPa-g (-7.93 mmHg-g)
• Reference pressure not saturated
• Reference pressure difference
between first and second 0.7 kPa-g
(5.25 mmHg-g) or more
HINT:
Typical example values
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
P2420
Vent valve stuck open
(vent)
Following condition met during key-off
EVAP monitor:
• EVAP pressure change when vent
valve closed (ON) less than 0.3 kPag
(2.25 mmHg-g)
•
•
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Canister pump module
(Reference orifice,
leak detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet port
to canister pump
module, canister filter,
fuel tank vent hose)
ECM
While
ignition
switch OFF
2 trip
Canister pump module
(Reference orifice,
leak detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
ECM
While
ignition
switch OFF
2 trip
*
: The threshold value varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
HINT:
The vent valve is built into the pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-346).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System (See page ES-349).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours*1 after the ignition switch is turned off, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator
malfunctions based on the EVAP pressure.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–333
HINT:
*1: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) after 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
*2
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
-
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch
turned off.
-
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525
mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump
creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then
ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve is turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) is created in EVAP system, and EVAP
system pressure then measured. Write down measured value as it will
be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels
EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*2
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV is opened and then EVAP system pressure is measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak pressure
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak pressure measurement, leak check is
performed by comparing first and second 0.02 inch leak pressure
standards.
If stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard, ECM determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure is measured and then monitoring result is
recorded by ECM.
ES
-
: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES–334
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation A:
Operation B, E:
Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
Purge VSV:
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF
OFF
(vent)
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Vacuum Pump: OFF
ES
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
Pump Module
ON (closed)
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
(closed)
ON
A096746E18
ES–335
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P2419: Vent valve stuck closed
In operation B, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (a vacuum) through the 0.02 inch orifice.
The EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system pressure is then measured by the ECM, using the pressure
sensor, to determine the 0.02 inch leak pressure standard. If the pressure exceeds -1.0578 kPa (-7.93
mmHg)* 4 seconds after the vacuum pump is turned ON, the ECM interprets this as the vent valve
being stuck closed. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*
: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Vent Valve Stuck ON:
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
4 seconds
Sequence
Time
A
B
C
10 seconds
60 seconds
With 15 minutes
D
E
60 seconds
10
seconds
G036779E08
ES
ES–336
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P2420: Vent valve stuck open (vent)
In operation C, the vent valve turns ON (closes) and the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system
pressure is then measured by the ECM, using the pressure sensor, to conduct an EVAP leak check. If
the pressure does not increase when the vent valve is open, the ECM interprets this as the vent valve
being stuck open. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
EVAP Pressure when Vent Valve Stuck OFF:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
ES
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Positive
OK
Negative
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Malfunction
Sequence
Time
A
B
C
10 seconds
60 seconds
With 15 minutes
D
E
10
60 seconds
seconds
G036780E09
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2419: Vent valve stuck open
P2420: Vent valve stuck closed
Required sensors / components
Vent valve
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
P2419: 2 seconds
P2420: 10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 or 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–337
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Vent value stuck closed:
One of the following conditions is met
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. EVAP pressure just after reference pressure
measurement start
More than -1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg)
2. Reference pressure
Less than -4.85 kPa (-36.4 mmHg)
3. Reference pressure
-1.057 kPa (-7.93 mmHg) or more
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated
5. Difference between first reference pressure and
second reference pressure
0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg) or more
Vent value stuck open:
EVAP pressure change after EVAP canister vent valve
is ON
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-14).
ES
ES–338
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2610
ECM / PCM Internal Engine Off Timer Performance
DTC SUMMARY
DTC
P2610
Monitoring Items
Malfunction Detection Conditions
Soak timer (built into
ECM)
ECM internal malfunction
Trouble Areas
ECM
Detection
Timings
Engine
running
Detection
Logic
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
ES
To ensure the accuracy of the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) monitor values, the soak timer, which is built
into the ECM, measures 5 hours (+- 15 minutes) from when the ignition switch is turned off, before the
monitor is run. This allows the fuel to cool down, which stabilizes the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When 5
hours have elapsed, the ECM turns on.
Soak Timer Circuit:
Ignition Switch
ECM
IGSW
EFI Relay
+B
Power Source IC
15 A
MREL
Battery
Main Relay
Control IC
Soak Timer IC
A133262E02
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off, the soak timer activates the ECM to begin the EVAP system
monitor. While the engine is running, the ECM monitors the synchronization of the soak timer and the
CPU clock. If these two are not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction, illuminates the
MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2610: Soak timer (bulit into ECM)
Required sensors / components
ECM
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycles
Duration
10 minutes
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Starter
OFF
Engine
Running
ES–339
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Soak timer measurement when ECM CPU clock counts
10 minutes
Less than 7 minutes or more than 13 minutes
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• DTC P2610 is set if an internal ECM problem is detected. Diagnostic procedures are not required.
ECM replacement is required.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
REPLACE ECM
(a) Replace the ECM (See page ES-434).
NEXT
2
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
Start the engine and wait for 10 minutes or more.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
If no pending DTC is displayed, the repair has been
successfully completed.
OK:
No DTC output.
NG
OK
END
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–340
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2A00
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2A03
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
HINT:
• DTC P2A00 means malfunctions related to the bank 1 A/F sensor.
• DTC P2A03 means malfunctions related to the bank 2 A/F sensor.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 2.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and located near
the engine assembly.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-298).
DTC No.
P2A00
P2A03
DTC Detection Conditions
Calculated value for air-fuel ratio (A/F) sensor response
rate deterioration level is less than threshold
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
After engine is warmed up, the ECM performs air-fuel ratio feedback control to regulate the air-fuel ratio at
stoichiometric ratio. In addition, this vehicle performs Active A/F Ratio Control for approximately 10
seconds after preconditions met in order to measure the A/F sensor response rate. During active air-fuel
ratio control, the ECM forcibly increases and decreases the injection volume for certain amount based on
learned stoichiometric air-fuel ratio during usual air-fuel feedback control, and measures the A/F sensor
response rate. The ECM calculates the signal from the A/F sensor while performing the active A/F ratio
control and interprets the calculated value as an test value for A/F sensor response rate deterioration
level.
If the test value for A/F sensor response rate deterioration level is less than threshold, ECM interprets this
as a malfunction, and sets the DTC.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Air-fuel Ratio Sensor Output:
ES–341
Approximately 10 seconds
OFF
ON
Active A/F Control
Normal
Malfunction
A/F Sensor Output
ES
Increase
Fuel Injection Volume
Decrease
G034991E08
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the A/F sensor response monitor.
Engine Speed
“H”
Between 25 mph and
75 mph (40 km/h and
120 km/h)
Idling
Between 38 mph and
75 mph (60 km/h and
120 km/h)
“G”
Ignition Switch off
Time
Warming up
3 minutes
A079199E78
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (Procedure "A").
Tester
Display
G034992E04
ES–342
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2.
3.
4.
5.
ES
Turn the ignition switch on (Procedure "B").
Turn the tester on (Procedure "C").
Clear DTCs (Procedure "D").
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR INFO / MONITOR
RESULT (Procedure "E").
6. Check that AFS B1 is INCOMPL (Procedure "F").
7. Start the engine and warm it up (Procedure "G").
8. Drive the vehicle at between 25 mph and 75 mph (40 km/h and 120 km/h) for 3 minutes. However, the
vehicle should be driven at a constant speed (Procedure "H").
9. Check the monitor result values on the intelligent tester by selecting the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR INFO / TEST RESULT (Procedure "I").
HINT:
The test values changes after monitor completed.
10.If the values indicated on the tester does not change, perform READINESS MONITOR DRIVE
PATTERN for the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor (See page ES-17) (Procedure "J").
HINT:
Completion of all A/F sensor monitors are required to change the value in TEST RESULT.
11.Note the value of the Monitor Result (Procedure "K").
12.Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES
(Procedure "L").
13.Check if any DTCs (any pending DTCs) are set (Procedure "M").
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2A00: A/F sensor (Bank 1) slow response
P2A03: A/F sensor (Bank 2) slow response
Required Sensors / Components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required Sensors / Components (Related)
Vehicle speed sensor, Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 to 15 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F Sensor heater Sensor 1), P0100, P0101, P0102,
P0103 (MAF Sensor), P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT Sensor), P0115, P0116, P0117,
P0118 (ECT Sensor), P0120, P0121, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223, P2135
(TP Sensor), P0125 (Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop), P0171, P0172 (Fuel
System), P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306 (Misfire), P0335
(CKP Sensor), P0340 (CMP sensor), P0450, P0451, P0452, P0453, P0455, P0456
(EVAP System), P0500 (VSS), P2196, P2198 (A/F Sensor (Rationality))
Active A/F control
Performing
Active A/F control is performed when the following
conditions are met
-
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine coolant temperature
75°C (167°F) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine RPM
Less than 4,000 rpm
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel cut
OFF
Engine load
10 to 70%
Shift position
2 or more
Catalyst monitor
Not yet
Intake air amount
3.0 to 10.5 g/s
ES–343
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Response rate deterioration level
Less than 0.2 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-302).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using an intelligent
tester.
(a)Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b)Start the engine and turn the tester on.
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(d)Select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
(e)Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
(f) Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection
volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display (Sensor)
Injection Volumes
Status
Voltages
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1 (A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2 (HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
ES
ES–344
Case
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
3
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air-fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
4
ES
– Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check the graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
– To display the graph, select the following menu items on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II
/ ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2, and press the YES button and then the ENTER button followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
• DTC P2A00 or P2A03 may be also set, when the air-fuel ratio is stuck rich or lean.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a rich air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run rich.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a lean air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that
would cause the engine to run lean.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at
the time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2A00 AND/OR P2A03)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Turn the tester on.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00 and/or P2A03
A
P2A00 and/or P2A03 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2A00 or P2A03 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
A
GO TO DTC CHART
ES–345
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/
sensor connector.
Standard resistance:
Bank 1
Component Side:
A12
Bank 1
+B
HT
+B
HT
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
NG
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A126269E08
OK
Specified Conditions
Bank 2
AFAF+
A/F Sensor Front View
A13
Bank 2
Tester Connections
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
ES–346
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
A/F Sensor Connector
A12 Bank 1
+B
HT
1
2
3
4
AF+
AFFront View
ES
A13 Bank 2
HA2A
2
3
4
AF+
Specified Conditions
+B (A12-2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
+B (A13-2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch off.
(e) Disconnect the B46 ECM connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor connector and ECM connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
+B
1
Tester Connections
AF-
ECM:
E5
HA1A
A2A+
A2A-
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
Below 1 Ω
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A114635E04
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 1):
A/F Sensor Heater Relay
From
Battery
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B
A/F Heater Fuse
AFFrom EFI
Relay
Heater
Sensor
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
EFI No. 2
A1A-
Duty
Control
G035624E02
ES–347
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2A00 AND/OR P2A03)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00 and/or P2A03
A
No output
B
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
6
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
7
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2A00 AND/OR P2A03)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2A00 and/or P2A03
B
B
CHECK EXTREMELY RICH OR LEAN
ACTUAL AIR FUEL RATIO (REFER TO DTC
P0171 PROCEDURE)
ES
ES–348
A
END
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–349
EVAP System
RELATED DTCS
DTCs
Monitoring Items
P043E
0.02 inch orifice clogged (built into pump module)
P043F
0.02 inch orifice high-flow (built into pump module)
P0441
•
•
•
P0450
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) voltage abnormal fluctuation
P0451
•
•
P0452
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) voltage low
P0453
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) voltage high
P0455
EVAP gross leak
P0456
EVAP small leak
Purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve) stuck closed
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge flow
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) noise
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) signal becomes fixed/flat
P2401
Vacuum pump stuck OFF (built into pump module)
P2402
Vacuum pump stuck ON (built into pump module)
P2419
Vent valve stuck ON (closed) (built into pump module)
P2420
Vent valve stuck OFF (vent) (built into pump module)
P2610
Soak timer (built into ECM)
See procedure
ES-212
ES-218
ES-224
ES-232
ES-320
ES-326
ES-332
If any EVAP system DTCs are set, the malfunctioning area can be determined using the table below.
ES
ES–350
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTCs
Malfunctioning Areas
P043E
P0441 P0450 P0451 P0452 P0453 P0455 P0456
P043F
P2401
P2419 P2420
P2402
0.02 inch orifice clogged
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
ES
Pressure sensor stuck
Pressure sensor noise
Pressure sensor low output
Pressure sensor high output
Gross leak
Small leak
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
Vacuum pump stuck ON
Vent valve stuck ON (closed)
Vent valve stuck OFF (vent)
A106731E15
NOTICE:
If the 0.02 inch reference pressure difference between the first and second checks is greater than
the specification, the DTCs corresponding to the reference pressure (P043E, P043F, P0441, P0455,
P0456, P2401, P2420) will be all stored.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
After a repair, check Monitor Status by performing the Key-Off Monitor Confirmation and Purge Flow
Monitor Confirmation described below.
1. KEY-OFF MONITOR CONFIRMATION
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
(1) The vehicle has been driven for 10 minutes or more (in a city area or on a freeway)
(2) The fuel tank is less than 90% full
(3) The altitude is less than 8,000 ft (2,400 m)
(4) The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is between 4.4°C and 35°C (40°F and 95°F)
(5) The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is between 4.4°C and 35°C (40°F and 95°F)
(6) The vehicle remains stationary (the vehicle speed is 0 mph [0 km/h])
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Allow the engine to idle for at least 5 minutes.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2.
ES–351
(2) Turn the ignition switch off and wait for 6 hours (8 or 10.5 hours).
HINT:
Do not start the engine until checking MONITOR STATUS. If the engine is started, the steps
described above must be repeated.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(3) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR STATUS.
(4) Check the Monitor Status displayed on the tester.
HINT:
If INCMP is displayed, the monitor is not completed. Make sure that the preconditions have
been met, and perform the Monitor Conditions again.
PURGE FLOW MONITOR CONFIRMATION (P0441)
HINT:
Perform this monitor confirmation after the Key-Off Monitor Confirmation shows COMPL (complete).
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• The vehicle has been driven for 10 minutes or more (in a city area or on a freeway)
• The ECT is between 4.4°C and 35°C (40°F and 95°F)
• The IAT is between 4.4°C and 35°C (40°F and 95°F)
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Release the pressure from the fuel tank by removing and reinstalling the fuel tank cap.
(2) Warm the engine up until the ECT reaches more than 75°C (167°F).
(3) Increase the engine speed to 3,000 rpm once.
(4) Allow the engine to idle and turn the A/C ON for 1 minute.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to on and turn the tester on.
(4) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR STATUS.
(5) Check the Monitor Status displayed on the tester.
HINT:
If INCMP is displayed, the monitor is not completed. Make sure that the preconditions have
been met, and perform the Monitor Conditions again.
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to Checking Monitor Status (See page ES-14).
ES
ES–352
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
Location of EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System:
EVAP Hose
(To Throttle Body)
Purge VSV
(Vacuum Switching value)
Canister
Refueling Valve
Fuel Tank
Pump Module
ES
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Pump
Vent Value
Breeding Pipe
Air Inlet Port
Air Filter
Fuel Tank Cap
EVAP Hose
(From Canister)
Purge Line
A130687E01
HINT:
The canister is located near the fuel tank, underneath the body.
EVAP System Circuit:
Throttle Valve
Air Cleaner
ECM
Intake Manifold
Soak Timer
Pump Module
Fuel Tank Cap
Purge VSV
Canister
Air Filter
Refueling Valve
Resistance (0.08 inch)
Cut-off Valve
Fuel Tank
A126270E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–353
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed- loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
The following two monitors run to confirm appropriate EVAP system operation.
1. Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system leaks and pump module malfunctions.
The monitor starts 5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned off. More than 5 hours are required to
enough time the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
The electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system, and the
pressure is measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in
both the pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the
ignition switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
2. Purge flow monitor
The purge flow monitor consists of the two monitors. The 1st monitor is always conducted every time
and the 2nd monitor is activated if necessary.
• The 1st monitor
While the engine is running and the purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve) is ON (open), the ECM
monitors the purge flow by measuring the EVAP pressure change. If negative pressure is not
created, the ECM begins the 2nd monitor.
• The 2nd monitor
The vent valve is turned OFF (open) and the EVAP pressure is then measured. If the variation in
the pressure is less than 0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg), the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being
stuck closed, and illuminates the MIL and sets DTC P0441 (2 trip detection logic).
Atmospheric pressure check:
In order to ensure reliable malfunction detection, the variation between the atmospheric pressures,
before and after conduction of the purge flow monitor, is measured by the ECM.
ES
ES–354
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
EVAP Purge Flow:
Fuel Tank Cap
Refueling Valve
To Atmosphere
Purge VSV
(ON)
Fuel Tank
0.02 Inch Orifice
Canister
Pressure Sensor
ES
To Intake Manifold
Vent Valve (OFF)
Air Filter
ECM
Vacuum Pump (OFF)
Pump Module
Soak Timer
A126271E01
Components
Operations
Canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP (Evaporative Emissions) generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank is 100% full.
Purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses purge VSV to control EVAP
purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge
VSV. EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold is controlled by purge VSV duty cycle ratio
(current-carrying time). (Open: ON, Close: OFF)
Refueling valve
Controls EVAP pressure from fuel tank to canister. Valve consists of diaphragm, spring and
restrictor (diameter: 0.08 inch). When fuel vapor and pressure inside fuel tank increase, valve
opens. While EVAP is purged, valve closes and restrictor prevents a large amount of vacuum from
affecting pressure in fuel tank. Valve is opened while refueling. When valve is open, adding fuel into
fuel tank is possible.
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle overturns to prevent fuel from
spilling out.
Service port
Used for connecting vacuum gauge for inspecting EVAP system.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours (+- 15 min.) after ignition
switch turned off. This allows fuel to cool down, stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approx
5 hours elapsed, ECM activates.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. Pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP system closed. When ECM
turns valve OFF, EVAP system is vented. Negative pressure (vacuum) is created in EVAP system
to check for EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning on vent valve (closed) and operating
vacuum pump. (refer to fig. 1).
(b) Pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltages. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to pressure sensor, and uses feedback
from sensor to monitor EVAP system pressure (refer to fig 2).
(c) Vacuum pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
(d) 0.02 inch orifice
Has an opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum is produced through orifice by closing purge VSV,
turning off vent valve and operating vacuum pump, to monitor 0.02 inch leak pressure. 0.02 inch
leak pressure indicates a small leak of EVAP.
ES–355
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Pump Module (fig. 1):
Condition: Purge Flow
: Airflow
Condition: Leak Check
Vent Valve: ON
(closed)
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
To Air Filter
(Atmosphere)
Canister
0.02 Inch Orifice
From Refueling Valve
Pressure Sensor
ES
Vacuum Pump: OFF
Pressure Sensor Specification (fig. 2):
Output Voltage
Vacuum Pump: ON
Soak Timer Circuit (fig. 3):
Malfunction Area
ECM
Ignition Switch
IGSW
4.900 V
Engine Room
Junction Block
+B
15 A
4.150 V
MREL
Usable Range
Power Source
IC
Main Relay
Control IC
EFI Relay
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
Soak Timer IC
0.450 V
HINT:
60 kPa 110 kPa
Pressure
Battery
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kpa (760 mm Hg)
A118976E02
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0450 (See page ES-227).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
An intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
HINT:
• Using intelligent tester monitor results enables the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system to be
confirmed.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
ES–356
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the ignition switch off and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
Select the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Confirm DTCs and freeze frame data.
If any EVAP system DTCs are set, the malfunctioning
area can be determined using the table below.
DTCs
Malfunctioning Areas
ES
P043E
P043F
P0441 P0450 P0451 P0452 P0453 P0455 P0456
P2401
P2419 P2420
P2402
0.02 inch orifice clogged
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
Pressure sensor signal
becomes fixed/flax
Pressure sensor noise
Pressure sensor voltage low
Pressure sensor voltage high
Gross leak
Small leak
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
Vacuum pump stuck ON
Vent valve stuck ON (closed)
Vent valve stuck OFF (vent)
A106731E16
NOTICE:
If the 0.02 inch reference pressure difference
between the first and second checks is greater than
the specification, the DTCs corresponding to the
reference pressure (P043E, P043F, P0441, P0455,
P0456, P2401 and P2420) will all be stored.
NEXT
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
ES–357
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION)
NOTICE:
• In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION), the
series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK steps is performed
automatically by the intelligent tester. It takes a
maximum of approximately 15 minutes.
• Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the
fuel tank is more than 90% full because the cut-off
valve may be closed and making the leak check of the
fuel tank unavailable.
• Do not run the engine in this step.
• When the temperature of the fuel is 35°C (95°F) or
more, a large amount of vapor forms and any check
results become inaccurate. When performing the
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below
35°C (95°F).
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
(c) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK /
EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO OPERATION.
(d) After the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK is completed, check
for pending DTCs by selecting the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed, perform the Monitor
Confirmation after this repair is completed. After this
confirmation, check for pending DTCs. If no DTC is
displayed, the EVAP system is normal.
NEXT
ES
ES–358
3
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (MANUAL OPERATION)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ES
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Gross Leak
Positive
Negative
[Second 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard] x 0.2
Small Leak
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
No Leak
Normal Pressure
Steps
Time (Reference)
1/5
10 seconds
2/5
3/5
60 seconds
Within 15 minutes
4/5
5/5
10
60 seconds
seconds
G036782E08
NOTICE:
• In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (MANUAL OPERATION),
the series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK steps is
performed manually by the intelligent tester.
• Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the
fuel tank is more than 90% full because the cut-off
valve may be closed and making the leak check of the
fuel tank unavailable.
• Do not run the engine in this step.
• When the temperature of the fuel is 35°C (95°F) or
more, a large amount of vapor forms and any check
results become inaccurate. When performing the
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below
35°C (95°F).
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Clear DTCs (See page ES-31).
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS
CHECK / MANUAL OPERATION.
NEXT
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–359
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 1/5)
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
Pressure Sensor Noise
EVAP Pressure
ES
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time (Reference)
OK
1/5
10 seconds
G036783E04
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 1/5.
Result
DTCs*
P0451
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Virtually no variation in EVAP pressure
Not yet determined
A
EVAP pressure fluctuates by +-0.3 kPa (2.25
mmHg) or more
Pressure sensor noising
B
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on
the intelligent tester when checking.
B
A
Go to step 30
ES–360
5
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 1/5 TO 2/5)
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ES
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Vacuum Pump Stuck ON
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time (Reference)
1/5
2/5
10 seconds
60 seconds
G036784E04
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 1/5 and 2/5.
Result
DTCs*
Test Results
-
Virtually no variation in EVAP pressure
during step 1/5. Then decreases to 0.02 inch
leak pressure standard*
Not yet determined
A
Small difference between EVAP pressures
during steps 1/5 and 2/5
Vacuum pump stuck ON
B
P2402
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system are displayed
on the intelligent tester when checking.
HINT:
The first 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is the value
determined in step 2/5.
B
A
Go to step 23
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6
ES–361
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 2/5)
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Vacuum Pump Stuck OFF
0.02 Inch Orifice High-flow
4 sec
Positive
Negative
ES
Vent Valve Stuck Closed
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
OK
0.02 Inch Orifice Clogged
Steps
Time (Reference)
3/5
Within 15 minutes
2/5
60 seconds
G036785E06
HINT:
Make a note of the pressures checked steps (a) and (b)
below.
(a) Check the EVAP pressure 4 seconds after the vacuum
pump is activated*1 (Step (a)).
(b) Check the EVAP pressure again when it has stabilized.
This pressure is the 0.02 inch leak pressure standard
(Step (b)).
*1: The vacuum pump begins to operate as step 1/5 is
proceeded to step 2/5.
Result
DTCs*2
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
EVAP pressure in step (b) is between -4.85
kPa and -1.06 kPa (-36.38 mmHg and -7.95
mmHg)
Not yet determined
A
P043F and P2401
EVAP pressure in step (b) is -1.06 kPa (-7.95
mmHg) or more
•
•
B
P043E
EVAP pressure in step (b) is below -4.85 kPa
(-36.38 mmHg)
0.02 inch orifice clogged
C
P2419
EVAP pressure in step (a) is more than -1.06
kPa (-7.95 mmHg)
Vent valve stuck closed
D
-
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
*2: The DTCs related to the EVAP system displayed on
the intelligent tester when checking.
B
Go to step 11
C
Go to step 30
D
Go to step 19
ES–362
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
7
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 2/5 TO 3/5)
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ES
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Vent Valve Stuck
Open (vent)
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
2/5
3/5
Within 15 minutes
Time (Reference)
G036786E05
(a) Check the EVAP pressure increase in step 3/5.
Result
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
EVAP pressure increases by 0.3 kPa (2.25
mmHg) or more within 10 seconds of
proceeding from step 2/5 to step 3/5
Not yet determined
A
P2420
No variation in EVAP pressure despite
proceeding from step 2/5 to step 3/5
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
B
P0451
No variation in EVAP pressure during steps
1/5 through 3/5
Pressure sensor malfunction
C
-
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on
the intelligent tester when checking.
A
B
Go to step 20
C
Go to step 30
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–363
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 3/5)
ON
Purge VSV
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ES
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time (Reference)
3/5
Within 15 minutes
G038126E06
(a) Wait until the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa
(0.75 mmHg) for 30 seconds.
(b) Measure the EVAP pressure and record it.
HINT:
A few minutes are required for the EVAP pressure to
become saturated. When there is little fuel in the fuel
tank, it takes up to 15 minutes.
NEXT
ES–364
9
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 4/5)
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
ES
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Purge VSV Stuck Closed
Steps
4/5
Time (Reference)
10
seconds
G036776E10
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 4/5.
Result
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
-
EVAP pressure increases by 0.3 kPa (2.25
mmHg) or more within 10 seconds of
proceeding from step 3/5 to step 4/5
Not yet determined
A
P0441
EVAP pressure increases by 0.3 kPa (2.25
mmHg) or more within 10 seconds of
proceeding from step 3/5 to step 4/5
Problems in EVAP hose between pure VSV
and intake manifold
B
P0441
Variation in EVAP pressure less than 0.3 kPa
(2.25 mmHg) for 10 seconds, after
proceeding from step 3/5 to step 4/5
Purge VSV stuck closed
C
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on
an intelligent tester when checking.
A
B
Go to step 15
C
Go to step 12
ES–365
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
10
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 5/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ES
EVAP Pressure
Gross Leak
Positive
Negative
[Second 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard] x 0.2
Small Leak
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
No Leak
Steps
5/5
Time (Reference)
[Second 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard]
60 seconds
G036782E09
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 5/5.
(b) Compare the EVAP pressure in step 3/5 and the second
0.02 inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5).
Result
DTCs*
Test Results
-
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) lower than second
0.02 inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5)
Not yet determined (no leafage from EVAP
system)
A
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) higher than
[second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard
(step 5/5) x 0.2]
•
•
B
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) higher than second
0.02 inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5)
EVAP small leak
P0441 and P0455
P0456
Suspected Trouble Areas
Purge VSV stuck open
EVAP gross leak
Proceed to
C
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system are displayed
on the intelligent tester when checking.
A
Go to step 36
B
Go to step 12
ES–366
11
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 3/5)
ON
Purge VSV
ES
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
0.02 Inch Orifice
High-flow
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Time (Reference)
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
Vacuum Pump Stuck OFF
Positive
Negative
Steps
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
2/5
3/5
Within 15 minutes
60 seconds
G036788E06
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 3/5.
Result
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
P043F
EVAP pressure is less than [0.02 inch leak
pressure standard] measured in step 2/5
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
A
P2401
EVAP pressure is almost the same as [0.02
inch leak pressure standard] measure in step
2/5
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
B
*: The DTCs related to the EVAP system are displayed
on the intelligent tester when checking.
HINT:
The first 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is the value
determined in step 2/5.
A
Go to step 30
B
Go to step 23
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
12
ES–367
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (PURGE VSV)
Purge VSV
Hose
G035659E03
(a) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
EVAP VSV (ALONE).
(b) Disconnect the hose (connected to the canister) from the
purge VSV.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) On the tester, turn off the purge VSV (EVAP VSV: OFF).
(e) Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has no
suction.
(f) Using the tester, turn on the purge VSV (EVAP VSV:
ON).
(g) Use you finger to confirm that the purge VSV has
suction.
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
No suction when purge VSV
turned OFF, and suction
applied when turned ON
Purge VSV normal
A
Suction applied when purge
VSV turned OFF
Purge VSV stuck open
B
No suction when purge VSV
turned ON
•
•
Purge VSV stuck closed
Problems with EVAP
hose between purge VSV
and throttle body
C
(h) Reconnect the hose.
B
Go to step 14
C
Go to step 15
A
13
CHECK FUEL TANK CAP ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the fuel tank cap is correctly installed and
confirm the fuel tank cap meets OEM specification.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, check the fuel tank cap
using the tester.
(1) Tighten the fuel tank cap.
(2) Remove the fuel tank cap and install it onto a fuel
tank cap adaptor.
(3) Connect an EVAP tester pump hose to the adaptor,
and pressurize the cap to 3.2 to 3.7 kPa (24 to 28
mmHg) using an EVAP tester pump.
(4) Seal the adaptor and wait for 2 minutes.
(5) Check the pressure. If the pressure is 2 kPa (15
mmHg) or more, the fuel tank cap is normal.
ES
ES–368
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
-
A
Fuel tank cap correctly installed
•
•
•
Fuel tank cap loose
Fuel tank cap improperly installed
Defective fuel tank cap
Fuel tank cap does not meet OEM
specifications
No fuel tank cap
-
ES
14
B
C
A
Go to step 29
B
Go to step 27
C
Go to step 28
INSPECT NO. 1 VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
Purge VSV
Hose
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Disconnect the B19 purge VSV connector.
(c) Disconnect the hose (connected to the canister) from the
purge VSV.
(d) Start the engine.
(e) Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has no
suction.
Result
Test Results
G035660E03
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
No suction
ECM
A
Suction applied
Purge VSV
B
(f) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(g) Reconnect the hose.
15
A
Go to step 35
B
Go to step 31
CHECK EVAP HOSE (PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
Purge VSV
(a) Disconnect the hose (connected to the throttle body)
from the purge VSV.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Use your finger to confirm that the hose has suction.
Result
Test Results
Suction applied
Hose (Connected to the throttle body)
G035661E04
No suction
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
EVAP hose between purge
VSV and throttle body normal
A
•
•
Throttle body
EVAP hose between
purge VSV and throttle
body
(d) Reconnect the hose.
B
Go to step 26
B
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–369
A
16
INSPECT NO. 1 VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE (PURGE VSV)
(a) Remove the purge VSV.
(b) Apply battery voltage to the terminals of the purge VSV.
(c) Using compressed air, confirm that air flows from port A
to port B.
Result
Purge VSV:
Port A
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Area
Proceed to
Air flowed
Purge VSV normal
A
No air flow
Purge VSV
B
Port B
G035662E02
(d) Install the purge VSV.
B
Go to step 31
A
17
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE OF PURGE VSV)
(a) Disconnect the V2 purge VSV connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the purge
VSV connector and the body ground.
Result
Wire Harness Side:
Purge VSV Connector
V2
Test Results
Front View
Suspected Trouble Areas
Normal
A
Other than result above
Wire harness or connectors
between purge VSV and ECM
B
A052933E31
(d) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
B
A
Proceed to
Between 11 V and 14 V
Go to step 32
ES
ES–370
18
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector and the V2 purge
VSV connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
purge VSV connector and ECM connector.
Standard resistance
ECM:
E4
Tester Connections
ES
Specified Conditions
E4-34 (PRG) - V2-2
Below 1 Ω
E4-34 (PRG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
V2-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
PRG
Wire Harness Side:
Purge VSV Connector
OK
Go to step 35
NG
Go to step 32
V2
1
2
Front View
A114636E03
19
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FOR VENT VALVE)
ECM:
E8
VPMP
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
VENT VALVE (ALONE).
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal VPMP of the
ECM connector and the body ground when the vent
valve is turned ON (close) and OFF (vent) using the
tester.
Result
A131509E54
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 9 V and 14 V when
OFF
Below 3 V when ON
Vent valve
A
Below 3 V when OFF and ON
ECM
B
A
Go to step 22
B
Go to step 35
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
20
ES–371
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FOR VENT VALVE)
ECM:
A24
VPMP
(a) Turn the ignition switch on (IG).
(b) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
VENT VALVE (ALONE).
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal VPMP of the
ECM connector and the body ground when the vent
valve is turned ON (close) and OFF (vent) using the
tester.
Result
A131509E15
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 3 V when OFF and
ON
Power source of vent valve
A
Between 9 V and 14 V when
OFF
Below 3 V when ON
Vent valve
B
Between 9 V and 14 V when
OFF and ON
ECM
C
B
Go to step 22
C
Go to step 35
A
21
INSPECT PUMP MODULE (POWER SOURCE FOR VENT VALVE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch off.
Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Measure the voltage between terminal 9 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
Result
Test Results
L4
Wire Harness Side:
Normal
A
Between 0 V and 3 V
Power source wire harness
of vent valve
B
B
L4
Front View
A138726E01
Proceed to
Between 9 V and 14 V
(e) Reconnect the canister connector.
Canister Connector
A
Suspected Trouble Areas
Go to step 32
ES
ES–372
22
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT PUMP MODULE (VENT VALVE OPERATION)
Charcoal
Canister
Assembly:
(a) Turn the ignition switch to off.
(b) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(c) Apply the battery voltage to terminals 9 and 8 of the
pump module.
(d) Touch the pump module to confirm the vent valve
operation.
Result
8 (-)
9 (+)
Test Results
ES
A096743E08
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Operating
Wire harness between vent
valve and ECM
A
Not operating
Vent valve
B
(e) Reconnect the canister connector.
23
A
Go to step 32
B
Go to step 30
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FOR PUMP MODULE (VACUUM
PUMP))
(a) Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
VACUUM PUMP (ALONE).
(b) Measure the voltage between terminal MPMP of the
ECM connector and the body ground when the vacuum
pump is turned ON and OFF using the tester.
Result
ECM:
E8
MPMP
A131509E55
Test Results
Proceed to
Between 0 V and 3 V when
OFF
Between 9 V and 14 V when
ON
ECM normal
A
Between 9 V and 14 V when
OFF
Between 0 V and 3 V when
ON
ECM
B
B
A
Suspected Trouble Areas
Go to step 35
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
24
ES–373
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch off.
Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch on.
Select the following menu items on the tester:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
VACUUM PUMP (ALONE).
(e) Turn the vacuum pump ON.
(f) Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
Result
L4
Test Results
Wire Harness Side:
Canister Connector
L4
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 9 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Between 0 V and 3 V
Wire harness between ECM
and vacuum pump
B
(g) Reconnect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 32
Front View
A138726E01
A
25
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PUMP MODULE - GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to off.
(c) Check the resistance between terminal 6 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
Result
Wire Harness Side:
Canister Connector
L4
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Below 1 Ω
Vacuum Pump
A
10 kΩ or higher
Wire harness between
vacuum pump and body
ground
B
Front View
A085258E54
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
26
A
Go to step 30
B
Go to step 32
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Stop the engine.
Disconnect the EVAP hose from the throttle body.
Start the engine.
Use your finger to confirm that the port of the throttle
body has suction.
ES
ES–374
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Suction applied
EVAP hose between throttle body and
purge VSV
A
No suction
Throttle body
B
(e) Reconnect the EVAP hose.
ES
27
A
Go to step 33
B
Go to step 34
CORRECTLY REINSTALL OR REPLACE FUEL TANK CAP
HINT:
• When reinstalling the fuel tank cap, tighten it until a few
click sounds are heard.
• When replacing the fuel tank cap, use a fuel tank cap that
meets OEM specifications, and install it until a few click
sounds are heard.
NEXT
28
Go to step 37
REPLACE FUEL TANK CAP ASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the fuel tank cap, tighten it until a few click
sounds are heard.
NEXT
29
Go to step 37
LOCATE EVAP LEAK
(a) Disconnect the vent hose.
ES–375
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister
Air Filter
ES
Disconnect the Vent Hose here.
Fuel Cap
A130688E02
(b) Connect the EVAP pressure tester tool to the canister
with the adapter.
Canister
Pressure Gauge
Air Filter
Adapter
A130689E02
(c) Pressurize the EVAP system by 3.2 to 3.7 kPa (24 to 28
mmHg).
(d) Apply soapy water to the piping and the connecting parts
of the EVAP system.
(e) Look for areas where bubbles appear. This indicates
leak point.
(f) Repair or replace the leak point.
NEXT
Go to step 37
ES–376
30
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
NEXT
31
Go to step 37
REPLACE NO. 1 VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE (PURGE VSV)
Purge VSV
ES
(a) Disconnect the connector and 2 hoses from the purge
VSV.
(b) Remove the purge VSV.
(c) Install a new purge VSV.
(d) Reconnect the connector and 2 hoses.
NEXT
Go to step 37
A130690E01
32
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
NEXT
33
REPLACE EVAP HOSE (THROTTLE BODY - PURGE VSV)
NEXT
34
Go to step 37
Go to step 37
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the throttle body (See page ES-412).
(b) Check that the EVAP purge port of the throttle body is
not clogged. If necessary, replace the throttle body.
NEXT
35
Go to step 37
REPLACE ECM
(a) Replace the ECM (See page ES-434).
NEXT
36
Go to step 37
REPAIR OR REPLACE PARTS AND COMPONENTS INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTCS
(a) Repair the malfunctioning areas indicated by the DTCs
that had been confirmed when the vehicle was brought
in.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–377
NEXT
37
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION)
NOTICE:
• In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION), the
series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK steps are performed
automatically by the intelligent tester. It takes a
maximum of approximately 15 minutes.
• Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the
fuel tank is more than 90% full because the cut-off
valve may be closed and making the leak check of the
fuel tank unavailable.
• Do not run the engine in this step.
• When the temperature of the fuel is 35°C (95°F) or
more, a large amount of vapor forms and any check
results become inaccurate. When performing an EVAP
SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below 35°C
(95°F).
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page ES-31).
(b) On the intelligent tester, select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK /
EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO OPERATION.
(c) After the SYSTEM CHECK is completed, check for
pending DTCs by selecting the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is found, the repair has been
successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
ES
ES–378
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned on, the battery voltage is applied to terminal IGSW of the ECM. The
ECM MREL output signal causes a current to flow to the coil, closing the contacts of the EFI relay and
supplying power to terminal +B of the ECM.
If the ignition switch is turned off, the ECM holds the EFI relay ON for a maximum of 2 seconds to allow for
the initial setting of the throttle valve.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side J/B
ES
B-R
IGN
6
1D
ECM
J8
J/C
11
1J
B-O
B-O
B
B
J/C
B
J31
B
J32
B-O
9
E8 IGSW
I18
Ignition Switch
6 IG2
AM2 7
Engine Room R/B
R
AM2
B
2
L
1
2
2
EFI
2
2
1
EFI Relay
2
W-B
2
5
3
1
2
B
J2
J/C
B
2
W-G
2
35
IC4
B
C
J31
J/C
A
J32
B
1
E8
+B
A
J32
B
2
E8
+B2
8
E8
MREL
1
E6
E1
W-G
B
J3
W-B
Battery
11
IC4
EB
BR
EE
G032692E02
ES–379
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ECM (+B VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the A24
and B47 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E6
E8
E1
OK
+B
A131509E56
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
+B (E8-1) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
ECM:
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminal of the ECM
connector and body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E6
E1
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
E1 (E6-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
G035617E15
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (IGSW VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E6
and E8 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E6
E1
E8
IGSW
A131509E57
NG
OK
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
IGSW (E8-9) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
Go to step 6
ES
ES–380
4
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK FUSE (IGN FUSE)
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Measure the IGN fuse resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the IGN fuse.
Driver Side J/B:
NG
IGN Fuse
ES
CHECK FOR SHORTS IN ALL HARNESSES
AND CONNECTORS CONNECTED TO FUSE
AND REPLACE FUSE
A072891E02
OK
5
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Component
Side:
Ignition Switch
(a) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(b) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance
I18
Ignition Switch
Positions
Tester Conditions
Specified Conditions
LOCK
All Terminals
10 kΩ or higher
ACC
2-4
Below 1 Ω
ON
1-2, 1-4, 5-6
Below 1 Ω
START
1-3, 1-4, 3-4, 5-6, 5-7, 6-7
Below 1 Ω
A056879E39
(c) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
NG
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - IGNITION SWITCH, IGNITION SWITCH - ECM)
6
INSPECT ECM (MREL VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E6
and E8 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E6
E1 (-)
E8
MREL (+)
A131509E58
NG
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
MREL (E8-8) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM
ES–381
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
7
CHECK FUSE (EFI FUSE)
Engine
Room R/B:
EFI Fuse
(a) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the EFI fuse resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
NG
CHECK FOR SHORTS IN ALL HARNESSES
AND CONNECTORS CONNECTED TO FUSE
AND REPLACE FUSE
A072881E02
OK
8
INSPECT EFI RELAY (EFI RELAY)
(a) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Check the EFI relay resistance.
Standard resistance
B016200
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and
2)
(c) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE EFI RELAY
ES
ES–382
9
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EFI RELAY - ECM, EFI RELAY - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the EFI relay
and ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room R/B.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the ECM connector and EFI relay terminal.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room R/B:
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
EFI relay (1)- MREL (E8-8)
Below 1 Ω
EFI Relay
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E8
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
EFI relay (1) or MREL (E8-8) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(b) Check the harness and connector between the EFI relay
and body ground.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminal of the
EFI relay and body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
MREL
ECM Connector
A138728E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
EFI relay (2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(2) Reinstall the EFI relay.
(3) Reconnect the ECM connector.
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TERMINAL +B OF ECM - BATTERY
POSITIVE TERMINAL)
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–383
VC Output Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The ECM constantly generates 5 V power from the battery voltage supplied to the +B (BATT) terminal to
operate the microprocessor. The ECM also provides this power to the sensors through the VC output
circuit.
ECM
From EFI Fuse
From EFI Relay
Throttle Position Sensor, Accelerator
Pedal Position Sensor, etc. (Sensors
which have ICs)
ES
BATT
5 V Constant Voltage Circuit
+B
VC, VCPA,
VCP2
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor,
Intake Air Temperature Sensor, etc.
Microprocessor
R
A116143E24
When the VC circuit is short-circuited, the microprocessor in the ECM and sensors that are supplied
power through the VC circuit are inactivated because the power is not supplied from the VC circuit. Under
this condition, the system does not start up and the MIL does not illuminate even if the system
malfunctions.
HINT:
Under normal conditions, the MIL is illuminated for several seconds when the ignition switch is first turned
ON. The MIL goes off when the engine is started.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to the following pages.
• Throttle position sensor circuit (See page ES-116).
• Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit (See page ES-290).
• Canister pump module circuit (See page ES-227).
• VVT sensor circuit (See page ES-187).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MIL
(a) Check that the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) lights
up when turning the ignition switch ON.
OK:
MIL lights up
OK
SYSTEM OK
ES–384
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
2
CHECK COMMUNICATION BETWEEN INTELLIGENT TESTER AND ECM
(a) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Check the communication between an intelligent tester
and ECM.
Result
ES
Result
Proceed to
Communication is possible
A
Communication is not possible
B
A
GO TO MIL CIRCUIT
B
3
CHECK MIL (THROTTLE BODY)
(a) Disconnect the throttle body connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
(d) Reconnect the throttle body connector.
A
REPLACE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
B
4
CHECK MIL (ACCELERATOR PEDAL)
(a) Disconnect the accelerator pedal connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
(d) Reconnect the accelerator pedal connector.
A
B
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
ASSEMBLY
ES–385
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5
CHECK MIL (CANISTER PUMP MODULE)
(a) Disconnect the canister pump module connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
(d) Reconnect the canister pump module connector.
A
REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER
ASSEMBLY
B
6
CHECK MIL (VVT SENSOR FOR BANK 1)
(a) Disconnect the VVT sensor (bank 1) connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
(d) Reconnect the VVT sensor (bank 1) connector.
A
REPLACE VVT SENSOR FOR BANK 1
B
7
CHECK MIL (VVT SENSOR FOR BANK 2)
(a) Disconnect the VVT sensor (bank 2) connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
(d) Reconnect the VVT sensor (bank 2) connector.
A
REPLACE VVT SENSOR FOR BANK 2
B
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VC OUTPUT CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the throttle body connector.
ES
ES–386
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
ECM Connector
B1
Disconnect the accelerator pedal connector.
Disconnect the canister pump module connector.
Disconnect the VVT sensor (bank 1) connector.
Disconnect the VVT sensor (bank 2) connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Check the resistance.
Standard Resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connections
E47
Specified Conditions
VC (E4-23) - Body ground
VCPA (E8-26) - Body ground
VCP2
ES
VC
VCPA
A115981E02
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the throttle body connector.
Reconnect the accelerator pedal connector.
Reconnect the canister pump module connector.
Reconnect the VVT sensor (bank 1) connector.
Reconnect the VVT sensor (bank 2) connector.
Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
10 kΩ or higher
VCP2 (E8-27) - Body ground
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–27
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECM
E4
7
6
5
4
E6
E5
3
2
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1
8
7
6
5
4
E8
E7
3
6
1
2
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
5
4
3
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
2
1
8
7
7
6
5
4
3
1
2
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
27 26
25 24
23 22 21 20
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
25 24
23 22 21 20 19 18
34 33
35 34
33 32
31 30 29 28
32 31
35 34 33 32 31
31 30
29 28
32 31 30 29 28
30
29 28
30 29 28
27 26
ES
A121603E06
HINT:
The standard normal voltage between each pair of ECM
terminals is shown in the table below. The appropriate
conditions for checking each pair of terminals are also
indicated. The result of checks should be compared with the
standard normal voltage for that pair of terminals, displayed in
the Specified Condition column. The illustration above can be
used as a reference to identify the ECM terminal locations.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
BATT (E8-3) - E1 (E6-1)
L - BR
Battery (for measuring
the battery voltage and
for the ECM memory)
Always
9 to 14 V
+BM (E8-7) - E1 (E6-1)
GR - BR
Power source of
throttle motor
Always
9 to 14 V
IGSW (E8-9) - E1 (E6-1)
B-O - BR
+B (E8-1) - E1 (E6-1)
B - BR
+B2 (E8-2) - E1 (E6-1)
B - BR
Condition
Specified Condition
Ignition switch
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
OC1+ (E6-17) - OC1- (E6-16)
G-Y - L-B
Camshaft timing oil
control valve (OCV)
OC2+ (E6-15) - OC2- (E6-14)
L-W - L-R
Camshaft timing oil
control valve (OCV)
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
MREL (E8-8) - E1 (E6-1)
W-G - BR
EFI relay
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
VC (E4-23) - E2 (E4-28)
L-R - BR
Power source for
sensors (specific
voltage)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.0 V
Mass air flow meter
Idling, Shift lever position P or N,
A/C switch OFF
0.5 to 3.0 V
VG (E4-30) - E2G (E4-29)
R-Y - R-W
THA (E4-22) - E2 (E4-28)
R-B - BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
Idling, Intake air temperature
20°C (68°F)
0.5 to 3.4 V
THW (E4-21) - E2 (E4-28)
B-L - BR
Engine coolant
temperature sensor
Idling, Engine coolant
temperature 80°C (176°F)
0.2 to 1.0 V
VTA1 (E4-20) - E2 (E4-28)
G-B - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, Throttle valve
fully closed
0.5 to 1.2 V
VTA1 (E4-20) - E2 (E4-28)
G-B - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, Throttle valve
fully open
3.2 to 4.8 V
VTA2 (E4-19) - E2 (E4-28)
G-W - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, Accelerator
pedal released
2.1 to 3.1 V
ES–28
Symbols (Terminal No.)
ES
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
VTA2 (E4-19) - E2 (E4-28)
G-W - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Condition
Specified Condition
Ignition switch ON, Accelerator
pedal depressed
4.5 to 5.0 V
VPA (E8-18) - EPA (E8-20)
W-R - LG-B
Accelerator pedal
position sensor (for
engine control)
Ignition switch ON, Accelerator
pedal released
0.5 to 1.1 V
VPA (E8-18) - EPA (E8-20)
W-R - LG-B
Accelerator pedal
position sensor (for
engine control)
Ignition switch ON, Accelerator
pedal depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
VPA2 (E8-19) - EPA2 (E8-21)
R-B - V-W
Accelerator pedal
position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, Accelerator
pedal released
1.2 to 2.0 V
VPA2 (E8-19) - EPA2 (E8-21)
R-B - V-W
Accelerator pedal
position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, Accelerator
pedal depressed
3.4 to 5.0 V
VCPA (E8-26) - EPA (E8-20)
B-Y - LG-B
Power source of
accelerator pedal
position sensor (for
VPA)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.0 V
VCP2 (E8-27) - EPA2 (E8-21)
W-L - V-W
Power source of
accelerator pedal
position sensor (for
VPA2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.0 V
HA1A (E5-2) - E04 (E5-7)
HA2A (E5-1) - E05 (E5-6)
R-L - W-B
B-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Idling
Below 3.0 V
HA1A (E5-2) - E04 (E5-7)
HA2A (E5-1) - E05 (E5-6)
R-L - W-B
B-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
A1A+ (E5-22) - E1 (E6-1)
P - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V*1
A1A+ (E5-22) - E1 (E6-1)
P - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V*1
A2A+ (E5-23) - E1 (E6-1)
Y - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V*1
A2A+ (E5-23) - E1 (E6-1)
Y - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V*1
A1A- (E5-30) - E1 (E6-1)
L - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V*1
A1A- (E5-30) - E1 (E6-1)
L - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V*1
A2A- (E5-31) - E1 (E6-1)
BR - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V*1
A2A- (E5-31) - E1 (E6-1)
BR - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V*1
HT1B (E4-1) - E1 (E6-1)
HT2B (E5-5) - E1 (E6-1)
G - BR
L - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Idling
HT1B (E4-1) - E1 (E6-1)
HT2B (E5-5) - E1 (E6-1)
G - BR
L - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Ignition switch ON
OX1B (E4-18) - E2 (E4-28)
OX2B (E5-33) - E2 (E4-28)
W - BR
B - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
Maintain engine speed at 2,500
rpm for 2 minutes after warming
up
Below 3.0 V
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
(see waveform 2)
#10 (E6-2) - E01 (E4-7)
#20 (E6-3) - E01 (E4-7)
#30 (E6-4) - E01 (E4-7)
#40 (E6-5) - E01 (E4-7)
#50 (E6-6) - E01 (E4-7)
#60 (E6-7) - E01 (E4-7)
R-L - BR
B - BR
R - BR
G - BR
Y - BR
L - BR
Injector
Ignition switch ON
#10 (E6-2) - E01 (E4-7)
#20 (E6-3) - E01 (E4-7)
#30 (E6-4) - E01 (E4-7)
#40 (E6-5) - E01 (E4-7)
#50 (E6-6) - E01 (E4-7)
#60 (E6-7) - E01 (E4-7)
R-L - BR
B - BR
R - BR
G - BR
Y - BR
L - BR
Injector
Idling
Pulse generation
(see waveform 3)
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000
rpm after warming up
Pulse generation
(see waveform 4)
KNK1 (E5-29) - EKNK (E5-28)
B -W
9 to 14 V
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
ES–29
Specified Condition
KNK2 (E5-21) - EKN2 (E5-20)
G-R
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000
rpm after warming up
VV1+ (E6-19) - VV1- (E6-29)
R-G
Variable valve timing
(VVT) sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(see waveform 5)
VV2+ (E6-18) - VV2+ (E6-28)
Y-L
Variable valve timing
(VVT) sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(see waveform 5)
NE+ (E6-21) - NE- (E6-20)
B -W
Crankshaft position
sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(see waveform 5)
Y-R - BR
P-L - BR
LG - BR
LG-B - BR
GR - BR
L - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition signal)
Idling
Pulse generation
(see waveform 6)
IGF1 (E4-24) - E1 (E6-1)
W-R - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation
signal)
Ignition switch ON
IGF1 (E4-24) - E1 (E6-1)
W-R - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation
signal)
Idling
PRG (E4-34) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - BR
EVAP VSV
Ignition switch ON
PRG (E4-34) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - BR
EVAP VSV
Idling
Pulse generation
(see waveform 7)
SPD (E7-8) - E1 (E6-1)
V-R - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
Ignition switch ON, Rotate driving
wheel slowly
Pulse generation
(see waveform 8)
STA (E6-11) - E1 (E6-1)
B-Y - BR
Starter signal
Cranking
9 to 14 V
Ignition switch ON, Other shift
position in P, N
9 to 14 V
IGT1 (E4-8) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT2 (E4-9) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT3 (E4-10) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT4 (E4-11) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT5 (E4-12) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT6 (E4-13) - E1 (E6-1)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 4)
ES
4.5 to 5.0 V
Pulse generation
(see waveform 6)
9 to 14 V
STAR/NSW (E5-8) - E1 (E6-1)
P - BR
Park/neutral position
switch signal
STAR/NSW (E5-8) - E1 (E6-1)
P - BR
Park/neutral position
switch signal
Ignition switch ON, Shift position
in P, N
0 to 3.0 V
STSW (E6-12) - E1 (E6-1)
L-Y - BR
Ignition switch signal
Shift lever position P or N, ignition
switch START
6.0 V or more
STP (E8-15) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - BR
Stop light switch
Brake pedal depressed
7.5 to 14 V
STP (E8-15) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - BR
Stop light switch
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
R-L - BR
Stop light switch
(opposite to STP
terminal)
Ignition switch ON, Brake pedal
depressed
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
R-L - BR
Stop light switch
(opposite and STP
terminal)
Ignition switch ON, Brake pedal
released
7.5 to 14 V
M+ (E4-5) - ME01 (E5-3)
P -W-B
Throttle motor
Idling with warm engine
Pulse generation
(see waveform 9)
M- (E4-4) - ME01 (E5-3)
L - W-B
Throttle motor
Idling with warm engine
Pulse generation
(see waveform 10)
GR-B - BR
Fuel pump control
Ignition switch ON
FPR (E6-30) - E1 (E6-1)
Y-B - BR
Fuel pump control
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
W (E7-30) - E1 (E6-1)
R-B - BR
MIL
Ignition switch ON
Below 3.0 V
W (E7-30) - E1 (E6-1)
R-B - BR
MIL
Idling
9 to 14 V
ELS1 (E7-13) - E1 (E6-1)
Y-G - BR
Electric load
Defogger switch OFF
0 to 1.5 V
ELS1 (E7-13) - E1 (E6-1)
Y-G - BR
Electric load
Defogger switch ON
7.5 to 14 V
ELS2 (E7-12) - E1 (E6-1)
G - BR
Electric load
Taillight switch OFF
0 to 1.5 V
7.5 to 14 V
FC (E8-10) - E1 (E6-1)
ELS2 (E7-12) - E1 (E6-1)
Electric load
Taillight switch ON
TC (E8-23) - E1 (E6-1)
P-L - BR
G - BR
Terminal TC of DLC 3
Defogger switch ON
TACH (E7-1) - E1 (E6-1)
B-W - BR
Engine speed
Idling
9 to 14 V
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
see waveform 11)
ACIS (E4-33) - E1 (E6-1)
W-L - BR
VSV for ACIS
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
PSW (E6-10) - E1 (E6-1)
G-W - BR
P/S pressure switch
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
ES–30
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
ES
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
VPMP (E8-5) - E1 (E6-1)
R-G - BR
Vent valve
(built into pump
module)
MPMP (E8-6) - E1 (E6-1)
O - BR
Vacuum pump
(built into pump
module)
Vacuum pump OFF
0 to 3 V
MPMP (E8-6) - E1 (E6-1)
O - BR
Vacuum pump
(built into pump
module)
Vacuum pump ON
9 to 14 V
PPMP (E8-22) - E2 (E4-28)
R - BR
Pressure sensor
(built into pump
module)
Ignition switch ON
3 to 3.6 V
F/PS (E7-32) - E1 (E6-1)
L - BR
Airbag sensor
assembly
Idling with warm engine
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
(see waveform 12)
HINT:
*1: The ECM terminal voltage is constant regardless of the
output voltage from the sensor.
1.
5 V/DIV
WAVEFORM 1
Camshaft timing oil control valve (OCV)
ECM Terminal Names
Between OC1+ and OC1- or OC2+ and OC2-
Tester Ranges
5 V/DIV, 1 msec./DIV
Conditions
Idling
Ground
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
1 msec./DIV
A093229E18
2.
0.2 V/DIV
WAVEFORM 2
Heated oxygen sensor
ECM Terminal Names
200 msec./DIV
A088863E20
3.
Ground
Tester Ranges
0.2 V/DIV, 200 msec./DIV
Conditions
Engine speed maintained 2,500 rpm for 2 minutes after
warming up sensor
HINT:
In the DATA LIST, item O2S B1S2 shows the ECM input
values from the heated oxygen sensor.
Ground
30 V/DIV
Between OX1B and E2 or OX2B and E2
WAVEFORM 3
Fuel injector
ECM Terminal Names
Between #10 (to 60) and E01
Tester Ranges
30 V/DIV, 20 msec./DIV
Conditions
Idling
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
20 msec./DIV
G035622E05
ES–31
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
KNK1 Signal Waveform
1 V/DIV
ECM Terminal Names
Between KNK1 and EKNK or KNK2 and EKN2
Tester Ranges
0.01 to 10 V/DIV, 0.01 to 10 msec./DIV
Conditions
Maintain engine speed 4,000 rpm after warming up
engine
Ground
HINT:
• The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
• The waveforms and amplitudes displayed differ
slightly depending on the vehicle.
1 msec./DIV
A085286E40
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
5.
2 V/DIV
(a)
NE
WAVEFORM 4
Knock sensor
WAVEFORM 5
(a) VVT sensor
(b) Crankshaft position sensor
GND
(b)
VV1
ECM Terminal Names
(a) Between NE+ and NE(b) Between VV1+ and VV1- or VV2+ and VV2-
Tester Ranges
2 V/DIV, 20 msec./DIV
Conditions
Idling
GND
VV2
GND
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
20 msec./DIV (Idling)
G035795E21
6.
IGT and IGF Signal Waveform
2 V/DIV
(a)
(a) Between IGT (1 to 6) and E1
(b) Between IGF1 and E1
Tester Ranges
2 V/DIV, 20 msec./DIV
Conditions
Idling
(b)
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
Ground
G035664E07
7.
5 V/DIV
Ground
50 msec./DIV
A093230E11
WAVEFORM 6
(a) Igniter IGT signal (from ECM to igniter)
(b) Igniter IGF signal (from igniter to ECM)
ECM Terminal Names
Ground
20 msec./DIV
ES
WAVEFORM 7
EVAP VSV
ECM Terminal Names
Between PRG and E01
Tester Ranges
5 V/DIV, 50 msec./DIV
Conditions
Idling
HINT:
If the waveform is not similar to the illustration, check the
waveform again after idling for 10 minutes or more.
ES–32
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8.
5 V/DIV
WAVEFORM 8
Vehicle speed signal
ECM Terminal Names
Between SPD and E1
Tester Ranges
5 V/DIV, 20 msec./DIV
Conditions
Ground
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the vehicle speed
increases.
20 msec./DIV
A093224E19
9.
ES
Driving at 12 mph (20 km/h)
5 V/DIV
WAVEFORM 9
Throttle actuator positive terminal
ECM Terminal Names
Tester Ranges
Conditions
Between M+ and ME01
5 V/DIV, 1 msec./DIV
Idling with warm engine
HINT:
The duty ratio varies depending on the throttle actuator
operation.
Ground
1 msec./DIV
A093274E19
10. WAVEFORM 10
Throttle actuator negative terminal
5 V/DIV
ECM Terminal Names
Tester Ranges
Conditions
Between M- and ME01
5 V/DIV, 1 msec./DIV
Idling with warm engine
HINT:
The duty ratio varies depending on the throttle actuator
operation.
Ground
1 msec./DIV
A093275E19
11. WAVEFORM 11
Engine speed signal
5 V/DIV
ECM Terminal Names
Tester Ranges
Conditions
Ground
Between TACH and E1
5 V/DIV, 10 msec./DIV
Idling
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
10 msec./DIV
A093225E17
12. WAVEFORM 12
Airbag sensor assembly
5 V/DIV
ECM Terminal Names
Ground
500 msec./DIV
A093227E08
Between F/PS and E1
Tester Ranges
5 V/DIV, 500 msec./DIV
Conditions
Idling with warm engine
ES–387
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fuel Pump Control Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0230 (See page ES-160)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC O0230 (See page ES-162)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION
(a) Check if there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose (See
page FU-4).
HINT:
If there is fuel pressure, you will hear the sound of fuel
flowing sound.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATION OF CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP/
SPD.
(d) Check whether operating sounds can be heard while
operating the relay using the tester.
OK:
Operating sounds can be heard from the relay.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
3
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the engine room
R/B.
(b) Check the circuit opening relay resistance.
Standard resistance
B016200
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and
2)
(c) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
ES
ES–388
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
OK
4
INSPECT ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch on.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E6
and E8 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E6
E8
ES
E1 (-)
FC (+)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
FC (E8-10) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE ECM
A131509E59
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (ECM - IGNITION SWITCH)
5
INSPECT ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
HINT:
Refer to "ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT" (See page ES372).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ECM POWER
SOURCE CIRCUIT
OK
6
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay the engine room R/B.
(b) Check the fuel pump relay resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
A030519
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage applied to terminal 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminal 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RELAY
ES–389
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
INSPECT FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
Component Side:
F14
(-)
(+)
Fuel Pump
A074356E25
(a) Inspect fuel pump resistance.
(1) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between terminals 4 and 5.
Standard resistance:
0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(b) Inspect fuel pump operation.
(1) Apply battery voltage to both terminals. Check that
the fuel pump operates.
NOTICE:
• These tests must be done quickly (within 10
seconds) to prevent the coil from burning
out.
• Keep the fuel pump as far away from the
battery as possible.
• Always switch at the battery side.
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL PUMP - FUEL PUMP RELAY RELAY, FUEL
PUMP - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump and circuit opening relay.
(1) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(2) Remove the Fuel pump relay from the engine room
R/B.
(3) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the fuel pump relay and fuel pump connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
F14
Fuel Pump Connector
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump (F14-4) - Fuel pump relay (4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Fuel Pump Relay
A138729E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump (F14-4) or Fuel pump relay (4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
(5) Reinstall the engine room junction block.
(b) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump and body ground.
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the terminal of the
fuel pump connector and body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump (F14-5) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(3) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
ES
ES–390
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
9
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY - FUEL PUMP RELAY)
Engine Room R/B:
Fuel Pump Relay
ES
Circuit Opening Relay
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the engine room
R/B.
(b) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room R/B.
(c) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Circuit opening relay (3) - Fuel pump relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A079233E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Circuit opening relay (3) or Fuel pump relay (3) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
(e) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EFI RELAY - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY)
10
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Check the fuel pump relay resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
3-4
Below 1 Ω
A030519
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage applied to terminal 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to terminal 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RELAY
ES–391
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
11
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RESISTOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Inspect the fuel pump resistor resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance:
0.70 to 0.76 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Ohmmeter
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RESISTOR
ES
G035666E02
OK
12
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL PUMP RELAY - FUEL PUMP)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump relay and fuel pump resistor.
(1) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room
R/B.
(2) Disconnect the F8 fuel pump resistor connector.
(3) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room R/B:
Fuel Pump Relay
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump relay (5) - Fuel pump relay resistor (F81)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Wire Harness Side:
F8
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump relay (5) - or Fuel pump resistor (F8-1)
- Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the fuel pump relay
(5) Reconnect the fuel pump resistor connector.
(b) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump resistor and fuel pump.
(1) Disconnect the F18 fuel pump resistor connector.
(2) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(3) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Fuel Pump Resistor Connector
Wire Harness Side:
F14
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump resistor (F8-2) - Fuel pump (F14-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Fuel Pump Connector
A138730E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Fuel pump resistor (F8-2) or Fuel pump (F14-4) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the fuel pump resistor connector.
(5) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
ES–392
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ES
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ES–393
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Cranking Holding Function Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The starter is controlled by the ECM, when the ECM detects a start signal (STSW) from the ignition
switch, this system monitors the engine speed (NE) and continues to operate the starter until it has
determined that the engine has started (engine speed reaches approximately 500 rpm). If the engine is
already running and the ignition switch is turned to START, the ECM will not operate the starter.
STA Relay
EFI
ACC CUT Relay
Ignition SW
STSW
ACC
AM2
ACCR
Park/Neutral
Position SW
ST2
P
STAR/
NSW
N
ACCR
STA
NO. 2
Starter
ENG rpm
ECM
Battery
STAR/NSW
STA
STSW
A074731E05
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0617 (See page ES-265).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF ENGINE CRANKING
(a) When turning the ignition switch to the ST position,
check whether the starter motor starts.
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / STARTER SIG.
(c) Read the values.
ES
ES–394
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard
STARTER SIG
Ignition Switch Position
OFF
ON
ON
START
OK
Go to step 5
NG
3
ES
INSPECT ECM (STAR AND STSW VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E5
and E6 ECM connectors, while cranking the engine.
Standard voltage
ECM:
E1 (-)
E5
E6
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
STAR/NSW (E5-8) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
STSW (E5-12) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
Result
STAR/NSW (+)
STSW (+)
Terminal STAR
Terminal STSW
Proceed to
9 to 14 V
9 to 14 V
A
0V
9 to 14 V
B
0V
0V
C
A131509E61
B
REPLACE ECM
C
Go to step 9
A
4
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the P1 park/neutral position switch
connector.
(b) Check for continuity between each terminal shown below
when the shift lever is moved to each position.
Standard
Component Side
P1
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Shift Position
Tester Connection
P
1-3
6-9
R
2-3
N
3-5
6-9
D
3-7
3
3-4
2, L
3-8
Specified Condition
Continuity
A137885E01
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
ES–395
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ECM)
5
INSPECT STARTER RELAY
(a) Remove the starter relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Inspect the starter relay.
Standard
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Continuity
No continuity
3-5
A060553
Continuity
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the starter relay.
NG
REPLACE STARTER RELAY
OK
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the park/
neutral position switch and starter relay.
(1) Disconnect the P1 park/neutral position switch
connector.
(2) Remove the starter relay from the engine room R/B.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
P1
Park/Neutral Position Switch Connector
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Park/neutral position switch (P1-6) - Starter relay
(1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Starter Relay
A138731E01
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Park/neutral position switch (P1-6) or Starter relay
(1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the park/neutral position switch
connector.
(5) Reinstall the starter relay.
(b) Check the harness and connector between the starter
relay, and body ground.
(1) Measure the resistance between each relay and
body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Starter relay (2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
ES
ES–396
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(2) Reinstall the starter relay.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
7
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK (STARTER RELAY VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the starter relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the engine
room R/B and body ground.
Standard voltage
Engine Room R/B:
ES
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
Starter relay (5) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(c) Reinstall the starter relay.
Starter Relay
A072892E02
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (STARTER RELAY - BATTERY)
OK
8
INSPECT STARTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the starter assembly (See page ST-13 for
Standard, ST-30 for Cold area).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STARTER ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (STARTER RELAY - STARTER, STARTER BATTERY)
9
CHECK FUSE (STA NO. 2)
(a) Remove the STA No. 2 fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Check for continuity in the STA No. 2 fuse.
Standard:
Continuity
(c) Reinstall the STA No. 2 fuse.
Driver Side J/B:
STA No. 2
Fuse
NG
A072893E01
OK
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESSES
AND CONNECTORS CONNECTED NO. 2 STA
FUSE AND REPLACE NO. 2 STA FUSE
ES–397
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
10
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Component Side:
ACC
IG1
AM1
(a) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(b) Check for continuity between the terminals shown in the
chart below.
Standard
ST1
I18
ST2
AM2
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
All terminal to terminal
No continuity
ACC
2-3
Continuity
ON
2 - 3, 2 - 4, 3 - 4, 6 - 7
Continuity
START
1 - 2, 1 - 4, 2 - 4, 6 - 7, 6 8, 7 - 8
Continuity
IG2
A056879E40
(c) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
NG
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM-BATTERT)
ES
ES–410
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSPECTION
1.
Acceptable
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
ES
RESISTANCE
kΩ
TEMPERATURE °C (°F)
Z017274E14
Specified Condition
1-2
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
If checking the engine coolant temperature
sensor in water, be careful not to allow
water to enter the terminals. After checking,
wipe the water off the engine coolant
temperature sensor.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
engine coolant temperature sensor.
ES–398
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ACIS Control Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit opens and closes the Intake Air Control Valve (IACV) in response to the engine load in order to
increase the intake efficiency (ACIS: Acoustic Control Induction System).
When the engine speed is between 2,200 and 4,100 rpm and the throttle valve opening angle is 60° or
more, the ECM supplies current to the VSV (ON status), so the IACV will close. Besides that condition,
the VSV is usually OFF and the IACV is open.
IACV closed (VSV: ON)
6
ES
4
Throttle Valve
opening angle
2
IACV
60°
Throttle Valve
5
3
1
2,200
4,100
Engine speed (rpm)
A078424E01
ES–399
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
B
35
IC4
W-G
2
2
3
2
1
1
2
5
2
EFI
No. 2
ES
2
A L-W
2
V1
ACIS VSV
J4 J/C
W-B
A
L-W
2
Engine
Room
R/B
1
Engine Room R/B
2
2
EFI
8 MREL
E8
W-G
17
IC3
L-W
12
IM1
L-W
W-L
1
2
33
ACIS
E4
J2 B
J/C
2
J3 B
B
W-B
Battery
EB
G032690E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE VSV FOR ACIS)
VSV is ON
Air
VSV is OFF
Air
Air Filter
Port F
Port E
Port F
Port E
A067588E06
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to ON and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(d) Select the item: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
ACTIVE TEST / INTAKE CTL VSV1. Operate the VSV
for AICS.
(e) Check the VSV operation when it is operated using the
intelligent tester.
Standard
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
VSV is ON
Air from port E flows out through port F
VSV is OFF
Air from port E flows out through the air filter
ES–400
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(f)
Reconnect the vacuum hose.
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
CHECK VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a)
(a) Check that air flows from port E to the air filter.
Air
Air Filter
ES
Port E
A054315E04
(b)
(b) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
Air
NG
Port E
Port F
Battery
A054316E04
OK
REPLACE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
ES–401
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VSV FOR ACIS - ECM, VSV FOR ACIS - EFI
RELAY)
(a) Check the wire harness and connectors between the
VSV for ACIS and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V1 VSV for ACIS connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the VSV for ACIS connector and ECM connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
VSV for ACIS connector
V1
Front View
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VSV for ACIS (V1-1) - ACIS (E4-33)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E6
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VSV for ACIS (V1-1) or ACIS (E4-33) - E1 (E6-1)
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the VSV for ACIS connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the wire harness between the VSV for ACIS and
EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the V1 VSV for ACIS connector.
(2) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B and
J/B.
(3) Measure the resistance of the VSV for ACIS
connector and engine room R/B (EFI fuse).
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
E1
ACIS
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
VSV for ACIS (V1-1) - EFI relay (3)
Below 1 Ω
(4) Reconnect the VSV for ACIS connector.
(5) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
NG
EFI Relay
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
A138727E01
OK
4
CHECK VACUUM HOSES
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and
disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, holes and damage.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
ES
ES–402
5
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE (INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK)
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
REPLACE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
ES–403
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp) is used to indicate vehicle malfunction detections by the ECM.
By turning the ignition switch on, power is supplied to the MIL circuit, and the ECM provides the circuit
ground, which illuminates the MIL.
The MIL operation can be checked visually: When the ignition switch is first turned on, the MIL should be
illuminated and should then turn off. If the MIL remains illuminated or is not illuminated, conduct the
following troubleshooting procedure using the intelligent tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ES
ECM
R
7
2
Engine
Room
R/B
2
AM2
6
2
I18
Ignition
Switch
30
E7 W
IG2
AM2
1
R-B
17 C8
B-R
Driver
Side
J/B
6 1D
B
Malfunction Combination
Indicator
Meter
Lamp
GAUGE
Battery
15 C10
4 1G
R-L
G032691E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Troubleshoot each trouble symptom in accordance with the table below.
MIL remains illuminated
Start inspection from step 1
MIL not illuminated
Start inspection from step 3
1
CHECK WHETHER MIL TURNS OFF
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Turn the tester on.
ES–404
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Check whether any DTCs have been stored (See page
ES-31). Note them down if necessary.
(e) Clear the DTCs (See page ES-31).
(f) Check if the MIL turns off.
OK:
MIL should turn off.
OK
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
NG
ES
2
ECM:
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
(a) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Check that the MIL is not illuminated.
OK:
MIL is not illuminated.
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
E7
OK
REPLACE ECM
G035618E25
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
3
CHECK THAT MIL IS ILLUMINATED
(a) Check if the MIL is illuminated when the ignition switch is
turned on.
OK:
MIL should be illuminated.
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (MIL CIRCUIT)
(a) See the combination meter troubleshooting procedure
(See page ME-4).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE BULB OR
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
ES–404
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – VVT SENSOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
ES
INSPECT VVT SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the voltage between terminal VC1 and
ground is 5 V.
HINT:
For the terminal arrangement of the engine ECU
(See page ES-23).
(c) While turning the crankshaft pulley by hand,
measure the voltage between each terminal.
Check that the voltage changes between the Hi
range and Lo range shown in the table below.
HINT:
For the terminal arrangement of the ECM (See page
ES-23).
Sensor position
Terminal No.
Voltage (Hi)
Voltage (Lo)
Bank 1
VV1+ ←→ VV1-
3.375 to 4.950
0.450 to 1.375
Bank 2
VV2+ ←→ VV2-
3.375 to 4.950
0.450 to 1.375
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – VVT SENSOR
ES–405
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
REMOVE V-BANK COVER (See page ES-413)
3.
DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES413)
5.
REMOVE VVT SENSOR
(a) RH bank side VVT sensor.
(1) Disconnect the VVT sensor connector.
(2) Remove the bolt and the VVT sensor.
ES
G038105
(b) LH bank side VVT sensor.
(1) Disconnect the water by-pass hoses No. 4 and
No. 5.
(2) Disconnect the VVT sensor connector.
A076414
(3) Remove the bolt and the VVT sensor.
G038106
INSTALLATION
1.
G038106
INSTALL VVT SENSOR
(a) LH bank side VVT sensor.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to an O-ring of
the VVT sensor.
(2) Install the VVT sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(3) Connect the VVT sensor connector.
ES–406
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – VVT SENSOR
(4) Connect the water by-pass hoses No. 4 and
No. 5.
A076414
(b) RH bank side VVT sensor.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to an O-ring of
the VVT sensor.
(2) Install the VVT sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(3) Connect the VVT sensor connector.
ES
G038105
2.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES415)
3.
CONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
4.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
5.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
6.
INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
ES–408
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CH-10)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the engine under cover
assembly rear.
3.
SEPARATE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the suction hose subassembly.
(b) Disconnect the cooler compressor assembly
connector.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and separate cooler
compressor assembly from the V-ribbed belt
tensioner assembly.
4.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor
connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and the crankshaft position sensor.
ES
A076416
A076417
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–409
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
RESISTANCE:
Cold:
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot:
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" mean the temperature of the
coils themselves. "Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to
50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to
100°C (212°F).
ES
ES–410
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to an O-ring of the
crankshaft position sensor.
(b) Install the crankshaft position sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
(c) Connect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
2.
ES
INSTALL COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the cooler compressor assembly with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the cooler compressor assembly
connector.
A076417
(c) Install the suction hose sub-assembly with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
A076416
3.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Install the engine under cover assembly rear with
the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CH-16)
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES–413
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
3.
REMOVE V-BANK COVER
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, then remove the V-bank cover.
ES
A075593E01
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the ventilation hose No. 2.
A075594E01
(b) Disconnect the vacuum hose.
(c) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(d) Remove the 2 wire harness clamps.
A075595E01
(e) Loosen the 2 hose clamps.
(f) Remove the 2 bolts, then remove the air cleaner.
A075596E01
ES–414
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
5.
REMOVE THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the water by-pass hose No. 5.
A075597E01
(b) Disconnect the water by-pass hose No. 4.
ES
A075598E01
(c) Disconnect the throttle motor connector.
(d) Remove the 4 bolts, then remove the throttle w/
motor body and gasket.
A075599E01
INSPECTION
1.
M+
MA059778E15
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Standard
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (M-) - 2 (M+)
0.3 to 100 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
throttle with motor body assembly.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES–415
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the throttle with motor body
with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the throttle motor connector.
A075599E01
(c) Connect the water by-pass hose No. 4.
ES
A075598E01
(d) Connect the water by-pass hose No. 5.
A075597E01
2.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Tighten the 2 hose clamps.
A075596E01
(c) Install the 2 wire harness clamps.
(d) Connect the mass air flow meter connector.
(e) Connect the vacuum hose.
A075595E01
ES–416
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
(f)
Connect the ventilation hose No. 2.
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
Torque: 3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
4.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
5.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE (See
page CO-4)
6.
INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
A075594E01
ES
A075593E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–427
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page EM-82)
2.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER INLET HOSE A
(a) Disconnect the heater water inlet hose A.
ES
A076171
3.
REMOVE WATER OUTLET PIPE NO.1
(a) Remove the 4 wire harness clamps [A].
(b) Remove the 3 bolts [B] and the water outlet pipe.
4.
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
[A]
[B]
[A]
[A]
[B]
[A] [B]
G038530E01
A075662
INSPECTION
1.
Ohmmeter
A065174E19
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between terminals.
Resistance:
120 to 280 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
ES–428
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
LH Bank:
INSTALLATION
Upper
Engine Rear
1.
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Install the 2 knock sensors with the 2 bolts as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
2.
INSTALL WATER OUTLET PIPE NO.1
(a) Install the 3 bolts [A] and the water outlet pipe.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the 4 wire harness clamps [B].
3.
CONNECT HEATER WATER INLET HOSE A
(a) Connect the heater water inlet hose A.
4.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page EM-85)
0 to 15°
ES
RH Bank:
Upper
Engine Front
0 to 15°
A078438E08
[B]
[A]
[B]
[B]
[A]
[B] [A]
G038530E02
A076171
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–33
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
FI00534E01
G039021
2.
3.
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting On-Board Diagnostics (OBD II)
vehicles, the intelligent tester (complying with SAE
J1987) must be connected to the Data Link Connector 3
(DLC3) of the vehicle. Various data in the vehicle's
Engine Control Module (ECM) can then be read.
OBD ll regulations require that the vehicle's on-board
computer illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer
detects a malfunction in:
(a)The emission control systems components
(b)The power train control components (which affect
vehicle emissions)
(c) The computer itself
In addition, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes
(DTCs) prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory. If the malfunction does not recur in 3
consecutive trips, the MIL turns off automatically but the
DTCs remain recorded in the ECM memory.
To check the DTCs, connect the intelligent tester to the
DLC3. The tester displays DTCs, freeze frame data, and
a variety of engine data. The DTCs and freeze frame
data can be erased with the tester. In order to enhance
OBD function on vehicles and develop the Off-Board
diagnosis system, the Control Area Network (CAN)
communication is used in this system. It minimizes the
gap between technician skills and vehicle technology.
CAN is a network which uses a pair of data transmission
lines that span multiple ECUs and sensors. It allows high
speed communication between the systems and
simplifies the wire harness connections. The CAN
Vehicle Interface Module (CAN VIM) must be connected
with the intelligent tester to display any information from
the ECM. The intelligent tester and ECM uses CAN
communication signals to communicate. Connect the
CAN VIM between the intelligent tester and DLC3.
NORMAL MODE AND CHECK MODE
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode during
normal vehicle use. In normal mode, 2 trip detection
logic is used to ensure accurate detection of
malfunctions. Check mode is also available as an option
for technicians. In check mode, 1 trip detection logic is
used for simulating malfunction symptoms and
increasing the system's ability to detect malfunctions,
including intermittent problems (intelligent tester only)
(See page ES-35).
2 TRIP DETECTION LOGIC
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is
temporarily stored in the ECM memory (1st trip). If the
same malfunction is detected during the next
subsequent drive cycle, the MIL is illuminated (2nd trip).
ES
ES–34
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
FREEZE FRAME DATA
Freeze frame data records the engine conditions (fuel
system, calculated engine load, engine coolant
temperature, fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed,
etc.) when malfunctions are detected. When
troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if
the vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was
warmed up or not, if the air fuel ratio was lean or rich,
and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
5.
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 3 (DLC3)
The vehicle's ECM uses the ISO 15765-4 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of
the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the
ISO 15765-4 format.
DLC3
ES
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 1112131415 16
A082779E98
Symbols
Terminal No.
Names
Reference terminal
Results
Condition
SIL
CG
7
Bus "+" line
5 - Signal ground
Pulse generation
During transmission
4
Chassis ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
SG
5
Signal ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
BAT
16
Battery positive
Body ground
11 to 14 V
Always
CANH
6
CAN "High" line
CANL
54 to 69 Ω
Ignition switch OFF
CANH
6
CAN "High" line
Battery positive
6 kΩ or higher
Ignition switch OFF
CANH
6
CAN "High" line
CG
200 Ω or higher
Ignition switch OFF
CANL
14
CAN "Low" line
Battery positive
6 kΩ or higher
Ignition switch OFF
CANL
14
CAN "Low" line
CG
200 Ω or higher
Ignition switch OFF
6.
HINT:
The DLC3 is the interface prepared for reading various
data from the vehicle's ECM. After connecting the cable
of an intelligent tester, turn the ignition switch to ON and
turn the tester ON.
If a communication failure message is displayed on the
tester screen (on the tester: UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE), a problem exists in either the vehicle or
tester. In order to identify the location of the problem,
connect the tester to another vehicle.
If communication is normal: Inspect the DLC3 on the
original vehicle.
If communication is impossible: The problem is probably
with the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the instruction manual.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery Voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the
battery before proceeding.
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–35
7.
MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
(a) The MIL is illuminated when the ignition switch is
first turned ON (the engine is not running).
(b) The MIL should turn OFF when the engine is
started. If the MIL remains illuminated, the diagnosis
system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in
the system.
HINT:
If the MIL is not illuminated when the ignition switch is first
turned ON, check the MIL circuit (See page ES-397).
ES
ES–36
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
NOTICE:
When the diagnosis system is changed from normal
mode to check mode or vice versa, all DTCs and freeze
frame data recorded in normal mode are erased. Before
changing modes, always check and make a note of DTCs
and freeze frame data.
HINT:
• DTCs stored in the ECM can be displayed on the
intelligent tester. The intelligent tester can display current
and pending DTCs.
• The some DTCs are not set if the ECM does not detect the
same malfunction again during a second consecutive
driving cycle. However, malfunctions detected on only one
occasion are stored as pending DTCs.
ES
1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
2.
DLC3
G039021E03
3.
CHECK DTC (Using the intelligent tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT
CODES.
(e) Check the DTC(s) and freeze frame data, and then
write them down.
(f) Check the details of the DTC(s) (See page ES-50).
CLEAR DTC (Using the intelligent tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES.
(e) Press the YES button.
CLEAR DTC (Without using the intelligent tester)
(a) Perform one of the following operations.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable for
more than 1 minute.
(2) Remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses from the
engine room junction block located inside the
engine compartment for more than 1 minute.
(b) Perform the initialization procedure (See page AT19).
ES–411
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
THROTTLE BODY
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ES
V-BANK COVER
THROTTLE BODY
ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
NO. 4 WATER
BY-PASS HOSE
VACUUM HOSE
11 (112, 9)
AIR CLEANER
ASSEMBLY
THROTTLE BODY
GASKET
THROTTLE MOTOR
CONNECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW
METER CONNECTOR
NO. 5 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A113542E03
ES–412
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
A075905
ES
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check for operating sound [A].
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) When turning the accelerator pedal position
sensor lever, listen to a running sound of the
motor. Also, check that there is no friction
sound.
If operation is not as specified, check the
throttle control motor (See page ES-414),
wiring and ECM.
(b) Inspect the throttle position sensor [B].
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) When turning the accelerator pedal position
sensor lever to the full-open position, check
that the percentage of throttle valve opening
angle (THROTTLE POS) of the CURRENT
DATA.
Standard percentage of the valve opening
angle:
60% or more
If operation is not as specified, check that the
accelerator pedal position sensor (See page
ES-436), the wiring and the ECM.
If you do not have the intelligent tester,
measure voltage between the terminals (VTA1
- E2, VTA2 - E2) of the ECM connector (See
page ES-23).
(c) Inspect the air assist system [C].
(1) Start the engine and check that the MIL does
not illuminate.
(2) Let the engine warm up to the normal operating
temperature.
(3) Switch the A/C compressor from ON to OFF,
and check the idle speed.
Idle speed (Transmission in neutral):
700 +- 50 rpm
NOTICE:
Perform inspection under condition without
electrical load.
(d) After checking the above [B] and [C], perform the
driving test.
ES–37
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FREEZE FRAME DATA
1.
DTC set point
0.5
0.5
Seconds Seconds 0.5 Seconds
Freeze frame data recorded point
G038619E03
2.
LABEL
(Intelligent Tester Display)
DESCRIPTION
(a) The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC
is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle
was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was
lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
HINT:
If it is impossible to replicate the problem even
though a DTC is detected, confirm the freeze frame
data.
(b) The ECM records engine conditions in the form of
freeze frame data every 0.5 seconds. Using the
intelligent tester, five separate sets of freeze frame
data, including the data values at the time when the
DTC was set, can be checked.
• 3 data sets before the DTC was set
• 1 data set when the DTC was set
• 1 data set after the DTC was set
These data sets can be used to simulate the
condition of the vehicle around the time of the
occurrence of the malfunction. The data may assist
in identifying of the cause of the malfunction, and in
judging whether it was temporary or not.
LIST OF FREEZE FRAME DATA
Measurement Item
Diagnostic Note
Freeze DTC
Freeze DTC
INJECTOR
Injector
-
Ignition advance
-
IGN ADVANCE
CALC LOAD
VEHICLE LOAD
MAF
Calculate load
Vehicle load
Mass air flow volume
-
Calculated load by ECM
If value approximately 0.0 g/s:
• Mass air flow meter power source circuit
open or short
• VG circuit open or short
If value 160.0 g/s or more:
• E2G circuit open
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
Engine coolant temperature
If value -40°C (-40°F), sensor circuit open
If value 140°C (284°F), sensor circuit shorted
Intake air temperature
If value -40°C (-40°F), sensor circuit open
If value 140°C (284°F), sensor circuit shorted
COOLANT TEMP
INTAKE AIR
-
AIR-FUEL RATIO
Air-fuel ratio
-
PURGE DENSITY
Learning value of purge density
-
Purge flow
-
EVAP PURGE VSV
PURGE FLOW
EVAP purge VSV duty ratio
-
KNOCK CRRT VAL
Correction learning value of knocking
-
Feedback value of knocking
-
KNOCK FB VAL
ES
ES–38
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
LABEL
(Intelligent Tester Display)
EVAP VAPOR PRES
Diagnostic Note
EVAP vapor pressure
-
ACCEL POS #1
Absolute Accelerator Pedal Position (APP)
No. 1
-
ACCEL POS #2
Absolute APP No. 2
-
THROTTLE POS
Throttle position
Read value with ignition switch on (Do not
start engine)
THROTTLE POS
Throttle sensor positioning
Read value with ignition switch on (Do not
start engine)
THROTTLE POS#2
THROTTLE MOT
ES
Measurement Item
Throttle sensor positioning#2
-
Throttle motor
-
O2S B1 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of ACTIVE TEST enables technician
to check voltage output of sensor
O2S B2 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of ACTIVE TEST enables technician
to check voltage output of sensor
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of ACTIVE TEST enables technician
to check voltage output of sensor
AFS B2 S1
A/F sensor output
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of ACTIVE TEST enables technician
to check voltage output of sensor
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim (bank 1)
-
TOTAL FT #2
Total fuel trim (bank 2)
-
SHORT FT #1
Short-term fuel trim (bank 1)
Short-term fuel compensation used to
maintain air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel
ratio
LONG FT #1
Long-term fuel trim (bank 1)
Overall fuel compensation carried out in longterm to compensate a continual deviation of
short-term fuel trim from central valve
SHORT FT #2
Short-term fuel trim (bank 2)
Short-term fuel compensation used to
maintain air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel
ratio
LONG FT #2
Long-term fuel trim (bank 2)
Overall fuel compensation carried out in longterm to compensate a continual deviation of
short-term fuel trim from central valve
•
•
•
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel system status (bank 1)
•
•
•
•
•
FUEL SYS #2
Fuel system status (bank 2)
•
•
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet satisfied
conditions to go closed loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using heated oxygen
sensor as feedback for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to driving
conditions (fuel enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to detected
system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but heated
oxygen sensor, which used for fuel control
malfunctioning
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet satisfied
conditions to go closed loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using heated oxygen
sensor as feedback for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to driving
conditions (fuel enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to detected
system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but heated
oxygen sensor, which used for fuel control
malfunctioning
O2FT B1 S2
Fuel trim at heated oxygen sensor
Same as SHORT FT #1
O2FT B2 S2
Fuel trim at heated oxygen sensor
Same as SHORT FT #1
ES–39
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
LABEL
(Intelligent Tester Display)
AF FT B1 S1
AFS B1 S1
AF FT B2 S1
Measurement Item
Fuel trim at A/F sensor
A/F sensor output current
Diagnostic Note
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of ACTIVE TEST enables technician
to check current output of sensor
Fuel trim at A/F sensor
-
CAT TEMP B1 S1
Catalyst temperature
-
CAT TEMP B2 S1
Catalyst temperature
-
CAT TEMP B1 S2
Catalyst temperature
-
CAT TEMP B2 S2
Catalyst temperature
-
Sub heated oxygen sensor impedance
-
Sub heated oxygen sensor impedance
-
Initial engine coolant temperature
-
S O2S B1 S2
S O2S B2 S2
INI COOL TEMP
INI INTAKE TEMP
INJ VOL
STARTER SIG
PS SW
PS SIGNAL
Initial intake air temperature
-
Injection volume
-
Starter signal
-
Power steering signal
-
Power steering signal (history)
This signal status usually ON until ignition
switch turned off
CTP SW
Closed throttle position switch
-
A/C SIG
A/C signal
-
ELECT LOAD SIG
Electrical load signal
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch
-
BATTERY VOLTAGE
ATM PRESSURE
FUEL PMP SP CTL
ACIS CTRL B2
ACT VSV
Battery voltage
-
Atmospheric pressure
-
Fuel pump speed control status
-
ACIS VSV status
-
A/C cut status
-
VVT CTRL B2
VVT control status
-
EVAP (Purge) VSV
EVAP purge VSV
FUEL PUMP/SPD
VVT CTRL B1
Fuel pump speed status
VSV for EVAP controlled by ECM (ground
side duty control)
VVT control status
-
VACUUM PUMP
Key-off EVAP system pump status
-
EVAP VENT VAL
Key-off EVAP system vent valve status
-
TC and TE1 terminals of DLC3
-
ENG SPEED #1
TC/TE1
Engine speed for cylinder 1
-
ENG SPEED #2
Engine speed for cylinder 2
-
ENG SPEED #3
Engine speed for cylinder 3
-
ENG SPEED #4
Engine speed for cylinder 4
-
ENG SPEED #5
Engine speed for cylinder 5
-
Engine speed for cylinder 6
-
Engine speed for all cylinders
-
ENG SPEED #6
ENG SPEED ALL
VVTL AIM ANGL #1
VVT CHNG ANGL #1
VVT aim angle
-
VVT change angle
-
VVT OCV DUTY B1
VVT OCV operation duty
-
VVTL AIM ANGL #2
VVT aim angle
-
VVT change angle
-
VVT OCV operation duty
-
VVT CHNG ANGL #2
VVT OCV DUTY B2
FC IDL
Idle fuel cut
ON: when throttle valve fully closed and
engine speed over 1,500 rpm
ES
ES–40
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
LABEL
(Intelligent Tester Display)
ES
Measurement Item
FC TAU
FC TAU
IGNITION
Ignition
Diagnostic Note
The fuel cut is being performed under very
light load to prevent the engine combustion
from becoming incomplete
-
CYL #1
Cylinder #1 misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
CYL #2
Cylinder #2 misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
CYL #3
Cylinder #3 misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
CYL #4
Cylinder #4 misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
CYL #5
Cylinder #5 misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
CYL #6
Cylinder #6 misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
CYL ALL
All cylinder misfire rate
Displayed only during idling
MISFIRE RPM
Misfire RPM
-
MISFIRE LOAD
Misfire load
-
Misfire monitoring
-
MISFIRE MARGIN
ENG RUN TIME
Accumulated engine running time
-
TIME DTC CLEAR
Cumulative time after DTC cleared
-
DIST DTC CLEAR
WU CYC DTC CLEAR
MODEL CODE
FAN MOTOR
VAPOR PRESS
ENG OIL PRES SW
ENGINE TYPE
CYLINDER NUMBER
Accumulated distance after DTC cleared
-
Warm-up cycle after DTC cleared
-
Identifying the model code:
GRN21#
Electric fan motor
-
Vapor pressure
Pressure inside of fuel tank as read by the
vapor pressure sensor
Engine oil pressure switch signal
Always ON while engine is running
Identifying the engine type
1GR
Identifying the cylinder number
6
DESTINATION
Identifying the destination
A (America)
MODEL YEAR
Identifying the model year
200#
Identifying the engine system
GASLIN (gasoline engine)
SYSTEM
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–417
KNOCK SENSOR
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
V-BANK COVER
ES
12 (122, 9)
COOL AIR INLET W/ AIR CLEANER HOSE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
VACUUM HOSE
VENTILATION HOSE NO. 2
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
MASS AIR FLOW
METER CONNECTOR
BATTERY CLAMP
BATTERY
BATTERY TRAY
FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 1
FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FUEL PIPE CLAMP
A119805E01
ES–418
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
CLIP
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
ES
RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
FAN PULLEY
FAN SHROUD
21 (214, 15)
FAN W/ FLUID COUPLING
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A137117E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–419
ATF LEVEL GAUGE
OIL LEVEL GAUGE
12 (122, 9)
OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
TRANSMISSION OIL
FILLER TUBE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
O-RING
ES
O-RING
VANE PUMP CONNECTOR
VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
TERMINAL CAP
9.8 (100, 7)
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
GENERATOR
WIRE
GENERATOR
CONNECTOR
43 (438, 32)
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
43 (438, 32)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
25 (255, 18)
WIRE HARNESS CLAMP BRACKET
COOLER COMPRESSOR CONNECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119806E01
ES–420
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
WATER BY-PASS HOSE NO. 2
WATER BY-PASS HOSE NO. 3
O-RING
ES
WATER INLET
GASKET
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
WATER BY-PASS HOSE NO. 1
39 (398, 29)
V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER
IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
54 (551, 40)
IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 1
OIL COOLER HOSE (W/ OIL COOLER)
O-RING
10 (102, 7)
36 (367, 27)
OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
21 (214, 15)
OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
21 (214, 15)
OIL PA SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
10 (102, 7)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
GASKET
40 (408, 30)
OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119800E01
ES–421
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
28 (286, 21)
VSV CONNECTOR
WATER BY-PASS HOSE
ES
INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
VSV CONNECTOR
FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE
THROTTLE BODY
W/ MOTOR
CONNECTOR
SURGE TANK STAY NO. 2
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
SURGE TANK
STAY NO. 1
THROTTLE BODY BRACKET
VENTILATION HOSE NO. 1
21 (214, 15)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
GASKET
OIL BAFFLE PLATE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119844E01
ES–422
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
10 (102, 7)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
SEAL WASHER
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
10 (102, 7)
ES
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CYLINDER HEAD
COVER GASKET NO. 2
CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET
VVT SENSOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT TIMING
OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119949E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–423
TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
23 (235, 17)
TIMING GEAR CASE OR
TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
ES
23 (235, 17)
250 (2,549, 184)
23 (235, 17)
CHAIN VIBRATION
DAMPER NO. 2
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY NO. 1
NO. 1 CHAIN
SUB-ASSEMBLY
10 (102, 7)
CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
IDLE GEAR SHAFT NO. 1
IDLE GEAR NO. 1
O-RING
60 (612, 44)
IDLE GEAR
SHAFT NO. 2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A134409E01
ES–424
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
26 (265, 19)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
INTAKE MANIFOLD
COMPRESSION SPRING
ES
43 (440, 32)
GASKET
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
GASKET
GASKET
GASKET
48 (490, 35)
GASKET
62 (630, 46)
30 (306, 22)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
40 (408, 30)
HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE
(FROM HEATER UNIT)
WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
MANIFOLD STAY
40 (408, 30)
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
GASKET
O-RING
GASKET
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119808E01
ES–425
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
24 (245, 18)
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 3
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 1
NO. 1 CAMSHAFT
24 (245, 18)
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 2
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
ES
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 3
CAMSHAFT TIMING
GEAR ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
100 (1,020, 74)
NO. 2 CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
100 (1,020, 74)
*
1ST: 36 (367, 27)
2ND: TURN 180°
PLATE WASHER
19 (194, 14)
CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY NO. 2
CAMSHAFT BEARING NO. 2
CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
*: See title CYLINDER HEAD
A119809E01
ES–426
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
24 (245, 18)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 3
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 4
CAMSHAFT BEARING
CAP NO. 3
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
24 (245, 18)
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP NO. 2
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
ES
NO. 4 CAMSHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CAMSHAFT TIMING
GEAR ASSEMBLY
*
100 (1,020, 74)
100 (1,020, 74)
1ST: 36 (367, 27)
2ND: TURN 180°
19 (194, 14)
CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY NO. 3
PLATE WASHER
30 (306, 22)
CYLINDER HEAD LH
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO. 2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
*: See title CYLINDER HEAD
A119813E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–41
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Compared to normal mode, check mode is more sensitive to
malfunctions. Therefore, check mode can detect the
malfunctions that cannot be detected by normal mode.
NOTICE:
All the stored DTCs and freeze frame data are erased if:
1) the ECM is changed from normal mode to check mode
or vice versa; or 2) the ignition switch is turned from ON
to ACC or OFF while in check mode. Before changing
modes, always check and make a note of any DTCs and
freeze frame data.
1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE (Using the intelligent
tester)
(a) Check and ensure the following conditions:
(1) Positive (+) battery voltage of 11 V or more.
(2) Throttle valve fully closed.
(3) Transmission in the P or N position.
(4) A/C switch OFF.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn the tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / CHECK MODE.
(g) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode.
G039021E03
0.13 seconds
ON
OFF
0.13 seconds
A076900E08
(h) Make sure the MIL flashes as shown in the
illustration.
(i) Start the engine.
(j) Make sure the MIL turns OFF.
(k) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described
by the customer.
(l) Check DTCs and freeze frame data using the tester.
ES
ES–42
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
If any of the following DTCs are set, the ECM enters fail-safe
mode to allow the vehicle to be driven temporarily.
DTCs
ES
Components
Fail-Safe Operations
Fail-Safe Deactivation
Conditions
P0031, P0032, P0051 and P0052
Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) Sensor
Heater
ECM turns off A/F sensor heater
Ignition switch off
P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058
Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor
Heater
ECM turns off HO2 sensor heater
Ignition switch off
P0100, P0102 and P0103
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Meter
ECM calculates ignition timing
according to engine speed and
throttle valve position
Pass condition detected
P0110, P0112 and P0113
Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor
ECM estimates IAT to be 20°C
(68°F)
Pass condition detected
P0115, P0117 and P0118
Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Sensor
ECM estimates ECT to be 80°C
(176°F)
Pass condition detected
P0120, P0121, P0122, P0123,
P0220, P0222, P0223, P0604,
P0606, P0607, P0657, P2102,
P2103, P2111, P2112, P2118,
P2119 and P2135
Electronic Throttle Control
System (ETCS)
ECM cuts off throttle actuator
current and throttle valve returned
to 6.5° throttle position by return
spring
ECM then adjusts engine output
by controlling fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing in accordance with
accelerator pedal opening angle,
to allow vehicle to continue at
Pass condition detected and then
ignition switch turned off
minimal speed*
P0327, P0328, P0332 and P0333
Knock Sensor
ECM sets ignition timing to
maximum retard
Ignition switch off
P0351 to P0356
Igniter
ECM cuts fuel
Pass condition detected
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP)
Sensor
APP sensor has 2 sensor circuits:
Main and Sub
If either of circuits malfunctions,
ECM controls engine using the
other circuit
If both of circuits malfunction,
ECM regards accelerator pedal
as being released. As a result,
throttle valve is closed and engine
idles
Pass condition detected and then
ignition switch turned off
P2120, P2121, P2122, P2123,
P2125, P2127, P2128 and P2138
NOTE:
*
: The vehicle can be driven slowly when the accelerator
pedal is depressed firmly and slowly. If the accelerator pedal
is depressed quickly, the vehicle may speed up and slow
down erratically.
ES–43
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
By reading the DATA LIST displayed on an intelligent
tester, you can check values, including those of the
switches, sensors, and actuators, without removing any
parts. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method of shortening diagnostic
time.
NOTICE:
In the table below, the values listed under Normal
Condition are for reference only. Do not depend
solely on these values when determining whether or
not a part is faulty.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn the tester ON.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST.
(g) Check the values by referring to the table below.
HINT:
If no idling conditions are specified, the transmission
gear selector lever should be in the N or P position,
and the A/C switch and all accessory switches
should be OFF.
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
INJECTOR
Injection period of No. 1 cylinder:
Min.: 0 ms, Max.: 32.64 ms
1.6 to 2.4 ms: Idling
-
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition timing advance for No. 1
cylinder/
Min.: -64 deg., Max.: 63.5 deg.
BTDC 7 to 24°: Idling
-
•
•
-
CALC LOAD
VEHICLE LOAD
Calculated load by ECM:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
Vehicle load:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 25,700 %
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
11.4 to 16.4 %: Idling
13.1 to 18.9 %: Running
without load (2,500 rpm)
Actual vehicle load
If value approximately 0.0 g/sec:
• Mass air flow meter power
source circuit open
• VG circuit open or short
If value 160.0 g/sec or more:
• E2G circuit open
MAF
Air flow rate from MAF meter:
Min.: 0 g/sec, Max.: 655.35 g/sec
3.2 to 4.7 g/sec: Idling
13.1 to 18.9 g/sec: 2,500 rpm
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 16,383.75 rpm
650 to 750 rpm: Idling
-
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed:
Min.: 0 km/h, Max.: 255 km/h
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
80 to 100°C
(176 to 212°F):After warming up
Intake air temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
Equivalent to ambient air
temperature
•
•
•
INTAKE AIR
•
If value -40°C (-40°F): sensor
circuit open
If value 140°C (284°F) or
more: sensor circuit shorted
If value -40°C (-40°F): sensor
circuit open
If value 140°C (284°F) or
more: sensor circuit shorted
ES
ES–44
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
AIR-FUEL RATIO
0.8 to 1.2: During idling
PURGE DENSITY
Learning value of purge density/
Min.: -50 , Max.: 350
-40 to 0 %: Idling
Purge flow:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 102.4 %
0 to 100 %: Idling
EVAP (Purge) VSV control duty:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 100 %: During idling
Order signal from ECM
VAPOR PRES PUMP
Vapor pressure:
Min.: 33.853 kPa,
Max.: 125.596 kPa
Approximately 100 kPa:
Ignition switch ON
EVAP system pressure monitored
by canister pressure sensor
VAPOR PRES CALC
Vapor pressure: (calculated)
Min.: -5.632 kPa,
Max.: 7,153,264 kPa
Approximately 100 kPa:
Ignition switch ON
EVAP system pressure monitored
by canister pressure sensor
KNOCK CRRT VAL
Correction learning value of
knocking:
Min.: -64° CA, Max.: 1,984° CA
0 to 22 °CA:
Driving, 44 mph (70 km/h)
Service data
KNOCK FB VAL
Feedback value of knocking:
Min.: -64° CA, Max.: 1,984° CA
-22 to 0 °CA
Driving, 44 mph (70 km/h)
Service data
ACCEL POS #1
Absolute Accelerator Pedal
Position (APP) No. 1:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
10 to 22 %: Accelerator pedal
released
54 to 86 %: Accelerator pedal
fully depressed
-
ACCEL POS #2
Absolute APP No. 2:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
12 to 42 %: Accelerator pedal
released
66 to 98 %: Accelerator pedal
fully depressed
-
ACCEL POS #1
APP sensor No. 1 voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
0.5 to 1.1 V: Accelerator pedal
released.
2.6 to 4.5t V: Accelerator pedal
fully depressed.
-
ACCEL POS #2
APP sensor No. 2 voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
1.2 to 2.0 V: Accelerator pedal
released.
3.4 to 5.0 V: Accelerator pedal
fully depressed.
-
ACCEL IDL POS
Whether or not accelerator pedal
position sensor detecting idle:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
-
THRTL LEARN VAL
Throttle valve fully closed
(learned value):
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
0.4 to 0.8 V
-
ACCEL SSR #1 AD
Accelerator fully closed value
No.1 (AD):
Min.: 0, Max.: 4.9804 V
-
ETCS service data
ACCEL LRN VAL#1
Accelerator fully closed learning
value No.1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 124.512
-
ETCS service data
ACCEL LRN VAL#2
Accelerator fully closed learning
value No.2:
Min.: 0, Max.: 124.512
-
ETCS service data
FAIL #1
Whether or not fail safe function
executed:
ON or OFF
ON: ETCS has failed
-
FAIL #2
Whether or not fail safe function
executed:
ON or OFF
ON: ETCS has failed
-
ST1
Starter signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
SYS GUARD JUDGE
System guard:
ON or OFF
-
EVAP PURGE FLOW
EVAP PURGE VSV
ES
Measurement Item/Range
Air-fuel ratio:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
Service data
-
ETCS service data
ES–45
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
OPN MALFUNCTION
THROTTLE POS
Measurement Item/Range
Open side malfunction:
ON or OFF
Absolute throttle position sensor:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
Normal Condition
•
•
Diagnostic Note
ETCS service data
10 to 24 %: Throttle fully
closed
64 to 96 %: Throttle fully open
Read value with intrusive
operation (active test)
Whether or not throttle position
sensor detecting idle:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
-
THRTL REQ POS
Throttle requirement position:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
0.5 to 1.0 V: Idling
-
THROTTLE POS
Throttle sensor positioning:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 10 %: Idling
Calculated value based on VTA1
Throttle sensor positioning #2:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
-
Calculated value based on VTA2
THROTTL IDL POS
THROTTLE POS #2
•
0.5 to 1.2 V: Throttle fully
closed
3.2 to 4.8 V: Throttle fully
opened
THROTTLE POS #1
Throttle position No. 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position No. 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
THRTL COMND VAL
Throttle position command value:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.5 to 4.8 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE SSR #1
Throttle sensor opener position
No. 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.9804 V
0.6 to 1.0 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE SSR #2
Throttle sensor opener position
No. 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.9804 V
2.0 to 2.6 V
ETCS service data
THRTL SSR #1 AD
Throttle sensor opener position
No.1 (AD):
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.9804 V
0.6 to 0.9 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE MOT
Whether or not throttle motor
control permitted:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
Read value with ignition switch
ON (Do not start engine)
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle motor current:
Min.: 0 A, Max.: 80 A
0 to 3.0 A: Idling
-
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle motor:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0.5 to 40 %: Idling
-
THRTL MOT (OPN)
Throttle motor duty ratio (open):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
-
ETCS service data
THRTL MOT (CLS)
Throttle motor duty ratio (close):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
-
ETCS service data
O2S B1 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output
voltage for bank 1 sensor 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 1.275 V
0.1 to 0.9 V:
Driving 44 mph (70 km/h)
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check voltage output of sensor
O2S B2 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output
voltage for bank 2 sensor 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 1.275 V
0.1 to 0.9 V:
Driving 44 mph (70 km/h)
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check voltage output of sensor
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output voltage for
bank 1 sensor 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 7.999 V
2.8 to 3.8 V: Idling
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check voltage output of sensor
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output current for
bank 1 sensor 1:
Min.: -128 mA, Max.: 127.99 mA
-
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check voltage output of sensor
•
•
•
2.0 to 2.9 V: Throttle fully
closed
4.6 to 5.0 V: Throttle fully
open
-
Read value with intrusive
operation (active test)
ES
ES–46
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
ES
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
2.8 to 3.8 V: Idling
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check voltage output of sensor
A/F sensor output current for
bank 2 sensor 1:
Min.: -128 mA, Max.: 127.99 mA
-
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check current output of sensor
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim of bank 1
Average value for fuel trim
system of bank 1:
Min.: -0.5, Max.: 0.496
-0.2 to 0.2: Idling
-
TOTAL FT #2
Total fuel trim of bank 2
Average value for fuel trim
system of bank 2:
Min.: -0.5, Max.: 0.496
-0.2 to 0.2: Idling
-
SHORT FT #1
Short-term fuel trim of bank 1:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2%
0 +- 20 %
Short-term fuel compensation
used to maintain air-fuel ratio at
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio
LONG FT #1
Long-term fuel trim of bank 1:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
0 +- 20 %
Overall fuel compensation carried
out in long-term to compensate
continual deviation of short-term
fuel trim from central value
SHORT FT #2
Short-term fuel trim of bank 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2%
0 +- 20 %
Short-term fuel compensation
used to maintain air-fuel ratio at
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio
LONG FT #2
Long-term fuel trim of bank 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
0 +- 20 %
Overall fuel compensation carried
out in long-term to compensate
continual deviation of short-term
fuel trim from central value
AFS B2 S1
A/F sensor output voltage for
bank 2 sensor 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 7.999 V
AFS B2 S1
•
•
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel system status (Bank1):
OL or CL or OL DRIVE or OL
FAULT or CL FAULT
•
CL: Idling after warming up
•
•
•
•
FUEL SYS #2
Fuel system status (Bank2):
OL or CL or OL DRIVE or OL
FAULT or CL FAULT
•
CL: Idling after warming up
•
•
O2FT B1 S2
Short-term fuel trim associated
with bank 1 sensor 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
-
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet
satisfied conditions to go
closed loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using
heated oxygen sensor as
feedback for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel
enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to
detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but
heated oxygen sensor, which
used for fuel control,
malfunctioning
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet
satisfied conditions to go
closed loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using
heated oxygen sensor as
feedback for fuel control.
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel
enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to
detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but
heated oxygen sensor, which
used for fuel control,
malfunctioning
-
ES–47
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
O2FT B2 S2
Short-term fuel trim associated
with bank 2 sensor 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
AF FT B1 S1
Short-term fuel trim associated
with bank 1 sensor 1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
Normal Condition
•
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output current for
bank 1 sensor 1:
Min.: -128 mA, Max.: 127.99 mA
Diagnostic Note
•
•
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = Lean
Stoichiometric air-fuel ratio=1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = RICH
Performing INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of ACTIVE
TEST enables technician to
check current output of sensor
-
•
-
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = Lean
Stoichiometric air-fuel ratio=1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = RICH
AF FT B2 S1
Short-term fuel trim associated
with bank 2 sensor 1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
CAT TEMP B1S1
Catalyst temperature (Bank 1,
Sensor 1):
Min.: -40, Max.: 6,513.5 °C
-
-
CAT TEMP B2S1
Catalyst temperature (Bank 2,
Sensor 1):
Min.: -40, Max.: 6,513.5 °C
-
-
CAT TEMP B1S2
Catalyst temperature (Bank 1,
Sensor 2):
Min.: -40, Max.: 6,513.5 °C
-
-
CAT TEMP B2S2
Catalyst temperature (Bank 2,
Sensor 2):
Min.: -40, Max.: 6,513.5 °C
-
-
S O2S B1 S2
Sub heated oxygen sensor
impedance (Bank 1, Sensor 2):
Min.: 0 Ω, Max.: 21247.68 Ω
-
-
S O2S B2 S2
Sub heated oxygen sensor
impedance (Bank 2, Sensor 2):
Min.: 0 Ω, Max.: 21247.68 Ω
-
-
Initial engine coolant
temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 120°C
Coolant temperature when
engine started
Service data
INI INTAKE TEMP
Initial intake air temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 120°C
Intake air temperature when
engine started
Service data
INJ VOL
Injection volume (cylinder 1):
Min.: 0 ml, Max.: 2.048 ml
0 to 0.5 ml
Quantity of fuel injection volume
for 10 times
Starter signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
Power steering signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Power steering operation
-
PS SIGNAL
Power steering signal (history):
ON or OFF
ON: When steering wheel first
turned after battery terminals
connected
This signal status usually ON until
battery terminals disconnected
CTP SW
Closed throttle position switch:
ON or OFF
ON: Throttle fully closed
OFF: Throttle open
-
A/C signal:
ON or OFF
ON: A/C ON
-
PNP switch status:
ON or OFF
ON: P or N position
-
ELECT LOAD SIG
Electrical load signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Headlights or defogger
turned ON
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch:
ON or OFF
ON: brake pedal depressed
-
INI COOL TEMP
STARTER SIG
PS SW
A/C SIGNAL
PNP SW [NSW]
•
•
-
ES
ES–48
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON: Ignition switch ON and
system normal
+BM voltage:
Min.: 0, Max.: 19.92182
11 to 14 (V): Ignition switch ON
and system normal
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 65.535 V
11 to 14 V: Idling
ACTUATOR POWER
Actuator power supply:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
Atmospheric pressure:
Min.: 0 kPa, Max.: 255 kPa
Equivalent to atmospheric
pressure (absolute pressure)
-
Fuel pump speed control status:
ON/H or OFF/L
Idling: ON
-
ACIS VSV
ACIS VSV:
ON or OFF
-
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ACT VSV
A/C cut status for Active Test:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
VVT CTRL B2
VVT control (bank 2) status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
EVAP (Purge) VSV
VSV status for EVAP control:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
FUEL PUMP / SPD
Fuel pump/status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
VVT CTRL B1
VVT control (bank 1) status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
VACUUM PUMP
Key-off EVAP system pump
status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
EVAP VENT VAL
Key-off EVAP system vent valve
status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
TC/TE1
TC and CG (TE1) terminal of
DLC3:
ON or OFF
-
-
ENG SPEED #1
Engine RPM for cylinder 1:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
ENG SPEED #2
Engine RPM for cylinder 2:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
ENG SPEED #3
Engine RPM for cylinder 3:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
ENG SPEED #4
Engine RPM for cylinder 4:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
ENG SPEED #5
Engine RPM for cylinder 5:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
ENG SPEED #6
Engine RPM for cylinder 6:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
ENG SPEED ALL
Engine RPM for all cylinders:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 25,600 rpm
-
Output only when FUEL CUT ALL
or COMPRESS CHECK is
performed using ACTIVE TEST
VVT aim angle (bank 1):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 100 %
VVT duty signal value during
intrusive operation
VVT change angle:
Min.: 0°FR, Max.: 60°FR
0 to 56 °FR
Displacement angle during
intrusive operation
+BM
+BM VOLTAGE
ATM PRESSURE
FUEL PMP SP CTL
ES
Measurement Item/Range
Whether or not electric throttle
control system power inputted:
ON or OFF
VVTL AIM ANGL #1
*1
VVT CHNG ANGL #1
*1
-
ETCS service data
ETCS service data
ES–49
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
VVT OCV DUTY B1
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VVT OCV operation duty:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 100 %
Requested duty value for
intrusive operation
VVT aim angle (bank 2):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 100 %
VVT duty signal value during
intrusive operation
VVT change angle (bank 2):
Min.: 0°FR, Max.: 60°FR
0 to 56 °FR
Displacement angle during
intrusive operation
VVT OCV (bank 2) operation
duty:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 100 %
Requested duty value for
intrusive operation
FC IDL
Fuel cut idle:
ON or OFF
ON: Fuel cut operation
FC IDL = "ON" when throttle
valve fully closed and engine
speed over 3,500 rpm
FC TAU
Fuel cut TAU: Fuel cut during very
light load:
ON or OFF
ON: Fuel cut operating
Fuel cut being performed under
very light load to prevent engine
combustion from becoming
incomplete
Ignition counter:
Min.: 0, Max.: 600
0 to 600
CYL #1
Misfire ratio of cylinder 1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
This item displayed in only idling
CYL #2
Misfire ratio of cylinder 2:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
This item displayed in only idling
CYL #3
Misfire ratio of cylinder 3:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
This item displayed in only idling
CYL #4
Misfire ratio of cylinde 4:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
This item displayed in only idling
CYL #5
Misfire ratio of cylinder 5:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
This item displayed in only idling
CYL #6
Misfire ratio of cylinder 6:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
This item displayed in only idling
CYL ALL
All cylinders misfire rate:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0 to 35
-
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire
range:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 6,375 rpm
0 rpm: Misfire 0
-
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range:
Min.: 0 g/rev, Max.: 3.98 g/rev
0 g/rev: Misfire 0
-
Margin to detect engine misfire:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.22 %
-100 to 99.2 %
Number of detected DTCs:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0: No DTC detected
Check mode:
ON or OFF
ON: Check mode ON
SPD TEST
Check mode result for vehicle
speed sensor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
MISFIRE TEST
Check mode result for misfire
monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
OXS2 TEST
Check mode result for HO2
sensor (bank 2) :
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
OXS1 TEST
Check mode result for HO2
sensor (bank 1) :
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
Check mode result for air-fuel
ratio sensor (bank 2) :
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
*1
VVTL AIM ANGL #2
*1
VVT CHNG ANGL #2
*1
VVT OCV DUTY B2
*
1
IGNITION
MISFIRE MARGIN
#CODES
CHECK MODE
A/F SSR TEST B2
-
Misfire detecting margin
See page ES-35
ES
ES–50
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Check mode result for air-fuel
ratio sensor (bank 1) :
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
MIL status:
ON or OFF
ON: MIL ON
-
MIL ON RUN DIST
MIL ON RUN Distance:
Min.: 0 km,
Max.: 65,535 km
Drive distance after DTC detected
-
MIL ON RUN TIME
Running time from MIL ON:
Min.: 0 min.,
Max.: 65,535 min.
Equivalent to running time after
MIL ON
-
Engine run time:
Min.: 0 s.,
Max.: 65,535 s.
Time after engine start
TIME DTC CLEAR
Time after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0 min.,
Max.: 65,535 min.
Equivalent to time after DTCs
erased
-
DIST DTC CLEAR
Distance after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0 km,
Max.: 65,535 km
Equivalent to drive distance after
DTCs erased
-
Number of warm-up cycles after
DTC cleared:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
-
A/F SSR TEST B1
MIL
ENG RUN TIME
ES
WU CYC DTC CLEAR
OBD CERT
Service data
OBD requirement
OBD2
-
#CARB CODES
Number of emission related
DTCs
0: No emission related DTC
detected
-
COMP MON
Comprehensive component
monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
FUEL MON
Fuel system monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
MISFIRE MON
Misfire monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
EGR MON
EGR monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
EGR MON
EGR monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) HTR
O2S (A/FS) heater monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) HTR
O2S (A/FS) heater monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) MON
O2S (A/FS) monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) MON
O2S (A/FS) monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
A/C MON
A/C monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
A/C MON
A/C monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
2nd AIR MON
2nd air monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
2nd AIR MON
2nd air monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
EVAP MON
EVAP monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
EVAP MON
EVAP monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
Heated catalyst monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
HTD CAT MON
ES–51
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Heated catalyst monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
CAT MON
Catalyst monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
CAT MON
Catalyst monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
CCM ENA
Comprehensive component
monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
CCM CMPL
Comprehensive component
monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
FUEL ENA
Fuel system monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
FUEL CMPL
Fuel system monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
MISFIRE ENA
Misfire monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
Misfire monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
EGR monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
EGR monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
HTR ENA
O2S (A/FS) heater monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
HTR CMPL
O2S (A/FS) heater monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) ENA
O2S (A/FS) monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
O2S (A/FS) CMPL
O2S (A/FS) monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
ACRF ENA
A/C monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
A/C monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
2nd air monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
AIR CMPL
2nd air monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
EVAP ENA
EVAP monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
EVAP monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
HCAT ENA
Heated catalyst monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
HCAT CMPL
Heated catalyst monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
Catalyst monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
Catalyst monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
MODEL CODE
Identifying model code
GSJ1##
-
ENGINE TYPE
Identifying engine type
1GRFE
-
Identifying cylinder number:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
6
-
Identifying transmission type:
MT or 5AT
MT: Manual transmission
5AT: Automatic transmission
-
HTD CAT MON
MISFIRE CMPL
EGR ENA
EGR CMPL
ACRF CMPL
AIR ENA
EVAP CMPL
CAT ENA
CAT CMPL
CYLINDER NUMBER
TRANSMISSION
ES
ES–52
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
DESTINATION
Identifying destination
A (America)
-
MODEL YEAR
Identifying model year:
Min.: 1900, Max.: 2155
200#
-
Identifying engine system
GASLIN (gasoline engine)
-
SYSTEM
2.
ES
Tester Display
*1: DATA LIST values are only displayed when
performing the following ACTIVE TESTs: VVT B1 or
VVT B2. For other ACTIVE TESTs, the DATA LIST
value will be 0.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing an ACTIVE TEST enables components
including the relays, VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve), and
actuators, to be operated without removing any parts.
The ACTIVE TEST can be performed with an intelligent
tester. Performing an ACTIVE TEST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method of shortening diagnostic
time.
DATA LIST can be displayed during ACTIVE TESTs.
(a) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST.
(e) Perform the ACTIVE TEST by referring to the table
below.
Test Part
Control Range
Diagnostic Notes
•
•
INJ VOL
Change injection volume
Between -12.5 % and 24.8 %
•
•
•
All injectors tested at same
time
Perform test at less than
3,000 rpm
Injection volume can be
changed in 0.1 % graduations
within control range
Perform test at less than
3,000 rpm
A/F CONTROL enables
checking and graphing of A/F
(Air Fuel Ratio) sensor and
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
voltage outputs
To conduct test, select
following menu items:
ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL / USER DATA /
AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2,
and press YES and ENTER
followed by F4
A/F CONTROL
Change injection volume
Lower by 12.5 % or increase by
25 %
FUEL PMP SP CTL
Fuel pump speed control
ON (low speed)/ OFF (high
speed)
-
INTAKE CTL VSV1
ACIS VSV
ON/OFF
-
EVAP VSV (ALONE)
Activate EVAP VSV control
ON/OFF
-
A/C CUT SIG
Control A/C cut signal
ON/OFF
-
FUEL PUMP/SPD
Activate fuel pump (C/OPN
Relay)
ON/OFF
-
•
ES–53
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Test Part
Control Range
Diagnostic Notes
•
TC/TE1
Turn on and off TC and CG (TE1)
connection
ON/OFF
FC IDL PROHBT
Prohibit idling fuel cut control
ON/OFF
ETCS OPEN SLOW
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve opens slowly
ETCS CLOSE SLOW
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve closes slowly
ETCS OPEN FAST
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve opens fast
ETCS CLOSE FAST
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve closes fast
Control the VVT (bank 1)
-128 to 127 %
This value added to present OCV
control duty
100 %: Maximum advance
-100 % : Maximum retard
VVT B1
•
Test possible when following
conditions met:
• Ignition switch ON
• Engine does not start
• Fully depressing accelerator
pedal (APP: 58 degrees or
more)
•
•
•
VVT CTRL B1
VVT B2
Turn on and off OCV
(Oil Control Valve)
ON/OFF
Control the VVT (bank 2)
-128 to 127 %
This value added to present OCV
control duty
100 %: Maximum advance
-100 % : Maximum retard
ON: TC and CG (TE1)
connected
OFF: TC and CG (TE1)
disconnected
•
•
•
•
Engine stall or rough idle
when VVT actuator operated
by 100 %
Test possible during engine
idling
Engine stalls or idles roughly
when OCV turned ON
Normal engine running or
idling when OCV off
Engine stall or rough idle
when VVT actuator operated
by 100 %
Test possible during engine
idling
Engine stalls or idles roughly
when OCV turned ON
Normal engine running or
idling when OCV off
VVT CTRL B2
Turn on and off OCV
(Oil Control Valve)
ON/OFF
VACUUM PUMP
Leak detection pump
ON/OFF
-
VENT VALVE
Vent valve
ON/OFF
-
FUEL CUT #1
Cylinder #1 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
FUEL CUT #2
Cylinder #2 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
FUEL CUT #3
Cylinder #3 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
FUEL CUT #4
Cylinder #4 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
FUEL CUT #5
Cylinder #5 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
FUEL CUT #6
Cylinder #6 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
FUEL CUT ALL
All cylinder injectors fuel cut
ON/OFF
COMPRESS CHECK
All cylinder injectors fuel cut and
ignition stop
ON/OFF
•
Test possible during vehicle
stopping and engine idling
*
HINT:
*: When cranking the engine, each cylinder
measures the engine rpm.
In this ACTIVE TEST, the fuel and ignition of all
cylinders are cut, and cranking occurs for
approximately 10 seconds. Then, each cylinder
measures the engine rpm. If a cylinder's engine rpm
is higher than the others, that cylinder's
compression pressure is compared to the others,
and is determined whether it is low or not.
1. Warm up the engine.
2. Turn the ignition switch off.
3. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the
intelligent tester on.
ES
ES–54
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ᵏ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ᵐ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ᵑ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ᵒ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ᵓ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ᵔ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ᵓᵏᵏᵗᵗ
ES
A133492
ᵏ
ᵐᵒᵑ
ᵐ
ᵐᵒᵒ
ᵑ
ᵐᵒᵓ
ᵒ
ᵐᵒᵒ
ᵓ
ᵐᵒᵒ
ᵔ
ᵐᵒᵒ
ᵐᵒᵒ
A133493
5. Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
COMPRESS CHECK.
HINT:
If the results are not displayed normally, select
the display items from the DATA LIST before
performing the ACTIVE TEST. Select the
following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / USER DATA /
ENG SPEED #1, ENG SPEED #2, ENG SPEED
#3, ENG SPEED #4, ENG SPEED #5, ENG
SPEED #6 (Press the YES button to change the
ENG SPEED #1 to #6) and then press the
ENTER button.
6. While the engine is not running, press the RIGHT
or LEFT button to change the COMPRESS
CHECK to ON.
HINT:
After performing the above procedure, the
ACTIVE TEST's COMPRESS CHECK will start.
Fuel injection for all cylinders is prohibited, and
each cylinder's engine rpm measurement will
enter standby mode.
7. Fully open the throttle.
8. Crank the engine for about 10 seconds.
9. Monitor the engine speed (ENG SPEED #1 to
#6) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
At first, the tester's display will show each
cylinder's engine rpm measurement to be
extremely high. After approximately 10 seconds
of engine cranking, each cylinder's engine rpm
measurement will change to the actual engine
rpm.
NOTICE:
• After the ACTIVE TEST's COMPRESS
CHECK is turned ON, it will automatically
turn off after 255 seconds.
• When the COMPRESS CHECK test is OFF
and the engine is cranked, the engine will
start.
• If the COMPRESS CHECK test needs to be
performed after it is turned ON and
performed once, press EXIT to return to
the ACTIVE TEST menu screen. Then
perform the COMPRESS CHECK test
again.
• Use a fully-charged battery.
ES–55
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3.
Tester Display
SYSTEM CHECK
HINT:
Performing a SYSTEM CHECK enables the system,
which consists of multiple actuators, to be operated
without removing any parts. In addition, it can show
whether or not any DTCs are set, and can detect
potential malfunctions in the system. The SYSTEM
CHECK can be performed with an intelligent tester.
(a) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK.
(e) Perform the SYSTEM CHECK by referring to the
table below.
Test Part
Control Range
Diagnostic Notes
•
EVAP SYS CHECK
(AUTO OPERATION)
Perform 5 steps in order to
operate EVAP key-off monitor
automatically
-
•
•
•
EVAP SYS CHECK
(MANUAL OPERATION)
Perform 5 steps in order to
operate EVAP key-off monitor
manually
•
•
If no DTCs in PENDING
CODE after performing this
test, system functioning
normally
Refer to EVAP Inspection
Procedure (See page ES343)
Recommended fuel
temperature is 35°C (95°F) or
less
Used to detect malfunctioning
parts
Refer to EVAP Inspection
Procedure (See page ES343)
Recommended fuel
temperature is 35°C (95°F) or
less
ES
ES–429
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – EFI RELAY
EFI RELAY
INSPECTION
Battery
1.
Ohmmeter
A098613E02
INSPECT EFI RELAY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the EFI
relay.
ES
ES–434
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
2.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO.2
4.
REMOVE ECM
(a) Disconnect the 5 the ECM connectors from the
ECM.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and the ECM.
(c) Remove the 2 screws and the ECM bracket No. 1
from the ECM.
(d) Remove the 2 screws and the ECM bracket No. 2
from the ECM.
ES
A072578
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ECM
(a) Install the ECM bracket No. 2 with the 2 screws to
the ECM.
(b) Install the ECM bracket No. 1 with the 2 screws to
the ECM.
(c) Install the ECM with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(d) Connect the 5 ECM connectors to the ECM.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO.2
3.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
A072578
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
ES–437
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• Avoid physical shock to the accelerator pedal
assembly.
• Do not disassemble the accelerator pedal
assembly.
(a) Install the accelerator pedal assembly with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the accelerator pedal connector.
ES
A067127
ES–430
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
INSPECTION
Battery
1.
Ohmmeter
ES
A098613E02
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
circuit opening relay.
ES–431
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – FUEL PUMP RELAY
FUEL PUMP RELAY
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Battery
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuel
pump relay.
A094494E01
ES
ES–432
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ECM
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ES
ECM
A119838E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ES–433
ES
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL LOWER NO.2
GLOVE COMPARTMENT
DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
B120192E01
1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM: ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD: REMOVAL (2007 4Run...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028B2002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM: ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the accelerator pedal connector.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
ES–3
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
FUEL INJECTOR
PURGE VSV
VSV FOR AIR INJECTION
CONTROL (BANK 1)
ECM
VSV FOR AIR INJECTION
CONTROL (BANK 2)
ACIS VSV
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
COMBINATION METER
PARK / NEUTRAL
POSITION SWITCH
THROTTLE BODY
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
MASS AIR FLOW METER
CANISTER
FUEL PUMP
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR (BANK 1
SENSOR 2)
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR (BANK 2
SENSOR 2)
DLC3
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
KNOCK SENSOR (NO. 2)
KNOCK SENSOR (NO. 1)
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK:
- STARTER RELAY
- EFI RELAY
- CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
A152304E01
ES
ES–4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(NO. 2 ASV) (BANK 2)
VVT SENSOR (BANK 2)
ES
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(NO. 2 ASV) (BANK 1)
OCV (BANK 2)
AIR PUMP
VVT SENSOR (BANK 1)
CAMSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(ASV)
IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
OCV (BANK 1)
A119841E03
ES–5
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
IG SW
ECM
IGSW
Combination Meter
W
MIL
To Battery
STSW
STA Relay
PNP SW
OC1+
STAR/NSW
STA
To Battery
VVT OCV
(Bank 1)
ES
OC1-
OC2+
VVT OCV
(Bank 2)
OC2-
To Starter
EFI
BATT
To Battery
EFI Relay
KNK1
Knock Sensor
(Bank 1)
EKNK
MREL
KNK2
Knock Sensor
(Bank 2)
EKN2
G2+
ETCS
To Battery
+BM
G2-
To VC
Terminal
Camshaft Position
Sensor
+B
Accelerate Pedal Position Sensor
+B2
NE+
VCPA
NE-
VPA
VV1+
EPA
VV1-
VCP2
VV2+
VPA2
VV2-
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
VVT Sensor
(Bank 1)
VVT Sensor
(Bank 2)
EPA2
G039841E05
ES–6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
To Battery
To A/F HEATER Relay
A/F Sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
HA1A
Fuel Injector #1
A1A+
A1AA/F Sensor (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
HA2A
A2A+
To EFI Relay
#10
Fuel Injector #2
#20
Fuel Injector #3
#30
Fuel Injector #4
A2AHO2 Sensor (Bank
1 Sensor 2)
ES
HT1B
OXIB
#40
Fuel Injector #5
#50
Fuel Injector #6
To EFI No. 2
Fuse
HO2 Sensor (Bank
2 Sensor 2)
HT2B
#60
Fuel Injector #7
OX2B
#70
E2
VSV (Purge)
Fuel Injector #8
#80
PRG
IGT1
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 1
IGT2
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 2
IGT3
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 3
IGT4
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 4
IGT5
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 5
IGT6
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 6
PPMP
IGT7
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 7
VPMP
IGT8
Ignition Coil and Igniter
No. 8
VSV (ACIS)
ACIS
VSV (AI Control)
AIV1
VSV (AI Control)
AIV2
Mass Air Flow
Meter
To VC
Terminal
THA
E2G
VG
E2
ETC Sensor
THW
Pump Module
Pressure Sensor
Control Valve
IGF1
MPMP
IGF2
G039842E03
ES–7
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
To Battery
To EFI Relay
ACC Cut Relay
AI Driver
ACCR
To Battery
AIDI
To IG SW
AIRP
AIRV
Air Pump
ASV
To E2
Terminal
Stop Light SW
To IGN1 Fuse
ST1Pressure
Sensor
AIP
ES
To Battery
STP
E01
Throttle Body
E02
GE01
E04
M+
M-
VTA1
To E2
Terminal
VC
E05
E1
E03
ME01
VTA2
EC
C/OPN Relay
To Battery
DLC3
FC
EOM
TC
To EFI Relay
Fuel Pump Relay
Fuel Pump Resister
TC
CANL
CANL
CANH
CANH
FPR
Fuel Pump
G039843E01
ES–8
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
*: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CONNECT INTELLIGENT TESTER TO DLC3*
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tester,
inspect the DLC3.
ES
NEXT
3
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
HINT:
Record or print DTCs and freeze frame data, if necessary
(See page ES-35).
NEXT
4
CLEAR DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
HINT:
(See page ES-35)
NEXT
5
CONDUCT VISUAL INSPECTION
NEXT
6
SET CHECK MODE DIAGNOSIS*
HINT:
(See page ES-36)
NEXT
ES–9
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
CONFIRM PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
HINT:
If the engine does not start, first perform the "check DTC"
procedures and "conduct basic inspection" procedures below.
B
Result
Proceed to
Malfunction does not occur
A
Malfunction occurs
B
GO TO STEP 9
A
8
ES
SIMULATE SYMPTOMS
NEXT
9
CHECK DTC*
HINT:
(See page ES-35)
B
Result
Proceed to
Malfunction code
A
No code
B
GO TO STEP 11
A
10
REFER TO DTC CHART
HINT:
(See page ES-48)
NEXT
GO TO STEP 13
11
CONDUCT BASIC INSPECTION
HINT:
(See page ES-10)
Result
Proceed to
Malfunctioning parts not confirmed
A
Malfunctioning parts confirmed
B
ES–10
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
GO TO STEP 16
A
12
REFER TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
(See page ES-26)
ES
Result
Proceed to
Malfunctioning circuit confirmed
A
Malfunctioning parts confirmed
B
B
GO TO STEP 16
A
13
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
HINT:
(See page ES-454)
NEXT
14
CONDUCT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Result
Proceed to
Malfunction not confirmed
A
Malfunction confirmed
B
B
GO TO STEP 17
A
15
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HINT:
(See page ES-10)
NEXT
GO TO STEP 17
16
NEXT
CONDUCT PARTS INSPECTION
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
17
ES–11
IDENTIFY PROBLEM
NEXT
18
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
19
NEXT
END
CONDUCT CONFIRMATION TEST
ES
ES–43
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
Tester Display
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
NOTICE:
In the table below, the values listed under "Normal
Condition" are reference values. Do not depend
solely on these reference values when deciding
whether a part is faulty or not.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST.
(g) According to the display on the tester, use the DATA
LIST.
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
INJECTOR
Injection period of the No. 1 cylinder:
Min.: 0 ms, Max.: 32.64 ms
2.3 to 3.8 ms: idling
-
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition timing advance for No. 1
cylinder:
Min.: -64 deg., Max.: 63.5 deg.
BTDC 4 to 17°: Idling
-
CALC LOAD
Calculated load by ECM:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
•
•
-
VEHICLE LOAD
Vehicle load:
Min.: 0%, Max.: 25700 %
11 to 21 %: Idling
12 to 22 %: Running without load
(2,500 rpm)
Actual vehicle load
-
MAF
Air flow rate from Mass air flow
(MAF) meter:
Min.: 0 g/sec., Max.: 655 g/sec.
2.0 to 3.9 g/sec.: Idling
If the value approximately 0.0 g/sec.:
• Mass air flow meter power
source circuit open
• VG circuit open or short if the
value 160.0 g/sec. or more:
• E2G circuit open
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 16,383 rpm
550 to 650 rpm: Idling
-
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed:
Min.: 0 km/h, Max.: 255 km/h
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
80 to 100°C (176 to 212°F): After
warming up
If the value -40°C (-40°F): sensor
circuit open
If the value 140°C (284°F): sensor
circuit shorted
INTAKE AIR
Intake air temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
Equivalent to ambient air
temperature
If the value -40°C (-40°F): sensor
circuit open
If the value 140°C (284°F): sensor
circuit shorted
SECONDARY AIR
Second air system status:
ON or OFF
ON: Second air system operation
-
AIR-FUEL RATIO
Air fuel ratio:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
0.8 to 1.2: During idling
-
PURGE DENSITY
Learning value of purge density:
Min.: -50, Max.: 350
Idling: -40 to 0 %
Service data
PURGE FLOW
Purge flow:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 102.4 %
0 to 100 %: Idling
-
ES
ES–44
Tester Display
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
EVAP PURGE VSV
Purge VSV control duty:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 100 %: During idling
Order signal from ECM
VAPOR PRESS
Vapor pressure:
Min.: -4.125 kPa, Max.: 2.125 kPa
0 KPa: Fuel tank cap removed
Pressure inside fuel tank monitored
by vapor pressure sensor
KNOCK CRRT VAL
Correction learning value of
knocking:
Min.: -64 CA, Max.: 1984 CA
0 to 22° CA:
Driving, 70 km/h (44 mph)
Service data
KNOCK FB VAL
Feedback value of knocking:
Min.: -64 CA, Max.: 1984 CA
-22 to 0° CA:
Driving, 70 km/h (44 mph)
Service data
EVAP VAPOR PRES
EVAP vapor pressure:
Min.: -8192 Pa, Max.: 8191 Pa
0 Pa: Fuel tank cap removed
-
ACCEL POS #1
Absolute Accelerator Pedal Position
(APP) No. 1:
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100 %
10 to 22 %: accelerator pedal is
released
54 to 86 %: accelerator pedal is fully
depressed
-
ACCEL POS #2
Absolute APP No. 2:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
12 to 42 %: accelerator pedal is
released
66 to 98 %: accelerator pedal is fully
depressed
-
ACCEL POS #1
APP sensor No. 1 voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
-
ETCS freeze data
ACCEL POS #2
APP sensor No. 2 voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
-
ETCS freeze data
ACCEL POS #1
APP sensor No. 1 voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
0.5 to 1.1 V: accelerator pedal is
released
2.6 to 4.5 V: or pedal is fully
depressed
-
ACCEL POS #2
APP sensor No. 2 voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
1.2 to 2.0 V: accelerator pedal is
released
3.4 to 5.3 V: accelerator pedal is fully
depressed
-
ACCEL IDL POS
Whether or not accelerator pedal
position sensor detecting idle:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
-
THRTL LEARN VAL
Throttle valve fully closed (learned
value)
0.4 to 0.8 V
-
ACCEL SSR #1 AD
Accelerator fully closed value No. 1
(AD):
Min.: 0, Max.: 4.98 V
-
ETCS service data
ACCEL LRN VAL#1
Accelerator fully closed learning
value No. 1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 124.512
-
ETCS service data
ACCEL LRN VAL#2
Accelerator fully closed learning
value No. 2:
Min.: 0, Max.: 124.512
-
ETCS service data
FAIL #1
Whether or not fail-safe function
executed:
ON or OFF
ON: ETCS has failed
-
FAIL #2
Whether or not fail-safe function
executed:
ON or OFF
ON: ETCS has failed
-
ST1
Stater signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
SYS GUARD JUDGE
System guard:
ON or OFF
-
ETCS service data
OPN MALFUNCTION
Open side malfunction:
ON or OFF
-
ETCS service data
THROTTLE POS
Absolute throttle position sensor:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
•
•
ES
10 to 24 %: Throttle fully closed
64 to 96 %: Throttle fully open
Read the value with intrusive
operation (Active Test)
ES–45
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
THROTTLE IDL POS
Whether or not throttle position
sensor detecting idle:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
-
THROTTLE REQ POS
Throttle requirement position:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
0.5 to 1.0 V: Idling
-
THROTTLE POS
Throttle sensor positioning:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
10 to 18 %: Idling
Calculated value based on VTA1
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle sensor positioning #2:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
-
Calculated value based on VTA2
THROTTLE POS #1
Throttle position sensor No. 1 output
voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.9 V
-
ETCS freeze data
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position sensor No. 2 output
voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.9 V
-
ETCS freeze data
THROTTLE POS #1
Throttle position No. 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
0.5 to 1.2 V: Throttle fully closed
3.2 to 4.8 V: Throttle fully open
-
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position No. 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
2.0 to 2.9 V: Throttle fully closed
4.6 to 5.5 V: Throttle fully open
Read the value with intrusive
operation (Active Test)
THRTL COMND VAL
Throttle position command value:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.5 to 4.8 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE SSR #1
Throttle sensor opener position No.
1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.6 to 0.9 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE SSR #2
Throttle sensor opener position No.
2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
2.2 to 2.6 V
ETCS service data
THRTL SSR #1 AD
Throttle sensor opener position No. 1
(AD):
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.6 to 0.9 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE MOT
Whether or not throttle actuator
control permitted:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
Read the value with the ignition
switch ON (Do not start engine)
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle actuator current:
Min.: 0 A, Max.: 80 A
0 to 3.0 A: Idling
-
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle actuator:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0.5 to 40 %: Idling
-
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle actuator current:
Min.: 0 A, Max.: 19.92 A
0 to 3.0 A: Idling
-
THROTL OPN DUTY
Throttle actuator opening duty ratio:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 40 %: During idling
When accelerator pedal depressed,
duty ratio increased
THROTL CLS DUTY
Throttle actuator closed duty ratio:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 to 40 %: During idling
When accelerator pedal released
quickly, duty ratio increased
THRTL MOT (OPN)
Throttle actuator duty ratio (open):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
-
ETCS service data
THRTL MOT (CLS)
Throttle actuator duty ratio (close):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
-
ETCS service data
O2S B1 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage
for bank 1 sensor 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 1.275 V
0.1 to 0.9 V:
Driving 44 mph (70 km/h)
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of the ACTIVE
TEST enables the technician to
check voltage output of the sensor
O2S B2 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage
for bank 2 sensor 2:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 1.275 V
0.1 to 0.9 V:
Driving 44 mph (70 km/h)
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of the ACTIVE
TEST enables the technician to
check voltage output of the sensor
AFS B1 S1
Air fuel ratio sensor output voltage for
bank 1 sensor 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 7.999 V
2.8 to 3.8 V: Idling
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of the ACTIVE
TEST enables the technician to
check voltage output of the sensor
ES
ES–46
Tester Display
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
AFS B2 S1
Air fuel ratio sensor output voltage for
bank 2 sensor 1:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 7.999 V
2.8 to 3.8 V: Idling
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of the ACTIVE
TEST enables the technician to
check voltage output of the sensor
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim of bank 1
Average value for fuel trim system of
bank 1:
Min.: -0.5 V, Max.: 1496 V
-0.2 to 0.2: idling
-
TOTAL FT #2
Total fuel trim of bank 2
Average value for fuel trim system of
bank 2:
Min.: -0.5 V, Max.: 1496 V
-0.2 to 0.2: idling
-
SHORT FT #1
Short-term fuel trim of bank 1:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
-20 to +20 %
This item refers to the short-term fuel
compensation used to maintain the
air fuel ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel
ratio
SHORT FT #2
Short-term fuel trim of bank 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
-20 to +20 %
This item refers to the short-term fuel
compensation used to maintain the
air fuel ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel
ratio
-20 to +20 %
This item refers to the overall fuel
compensation carried out in longterm to compensate a continual
deviation of the short-term fuel trim
from the central value
-20 to +20 %
This item refers to the overall fuel
compensation carried out in longterm to compensate a continual
deviation of the short-term fuel trim
from the central value
ES
LONG FT #1
Long-term fuel trim of bank 1:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
LONG FT #2
Long-term fuel trim of bank 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
•
•
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel system status (bank 1):
OL, CL, OL DRIVE, OL FAULT or CL
FAULT
•
CL: Idling after warming up
•
•
•
•
FUEL SYS #2
Fuel system status (bank 2):
OL, CL, OL DRIVE, OL FAULT or CL
FAULT
•
CL: Idling after warming up
•
•
O2 FT B1 S2
Short-term fuel trim associated with
the bank 1 sensor 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
-20 to +20 %
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet
satisfied conditions to go closed
loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using heated
oxygen sensor as feedback for
fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel
enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to
detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but
heated oxygen sensor, which
used for fuel control
malfunctioning
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet
satisfied conditions to go closed
loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using heated
oxygen sensor as feedback for
fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel
enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to
detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but
heated oxygen sensor, which
used for fuel control
malfunctioning
Same as SHORT FT #1
ES–47
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
O2 FT B2 S2
Short-term fuel trim associated with
the bank 2 sensor 2:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.2 %
AF FT B1 S1
Short-term fuel trim associated with
the bank 1 sensor 1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
AF FT B2 S1
Short-term fuel trim associated with
the bank 2 sensor 1:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
CAT TEMP B1S1
Catalyst temperature (bank 1, sensor
1):
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 6,513.5°C
-
-
CAT TEMP B2S1
Catalyst temperature (bank 2, sensor
1):
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 6,513.5°C
-
-
CAT TEMP B1S2
Catalyst temperature (bank 1, sensor
2):
Min.: -40, Max.: 6,513.5°C
-
-
CAT TEMP B2S2
Catalyst temperature (bank 2, sensor
2):
Min.: -40, Max.: 6,513.5°C
-
-
INI COOL TEMP
Initial engine coolant temperature:
Min.: -40°C , Max.: 140°C
Close to ambient air temperature
Service data
INI INTAKE TEMP
Initial intake air temperature:
Min.: -40°C , Max.: 140°C
Close to ambient air temperature
Service data
INJ VOL
Injection volume (cylinder 1):
Min.: 0 ml, Max.: 2.048 ml
0 to 0.5 ml
Quantity of fuel injection volume for
10 times
STARTER SIG
Starter signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
AIR PMP PRS (A)
Air pump pressure (absolute):
Min.: 0 kPa, Max.: 320 kPa
-
Air pump pressure (absolute)
ACC RELAY
Acc Relay status:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
STARTER RELAY
Starter relay status:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
STARTER CONTROL
Starter switch status:
ON or OFF
ON: Cranking
-
CTP SW
Closed throttle position switch:
ON or OFF
•
•
-
A/C SIGNAL
A/C signal:
ON or OFF
ON: A/C ON
-
ELECT LOAD SIG
Electrical load signal:
ON or OFF
ON: Headlights or defogger is turned
ON
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch:
ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed.
-
+BM
Whether or not electric throttle
control system power inputted:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
-
+BM VOLTAGE
+BM voltage:
Min.: 0, Max.: 19.92
10 to 15 V: Idling
ETCS service data
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery voltage:
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 65,535 V
9 to 14 V: Idling
-
ACTUATOR POWER
Actuator power supply:
ON or OFF
ON: Idling
ETCS service data
ATM PRESSURE
Atmospheric pressure:
Min.: 0 kPa, Max.: 150 kPa
Equivalent to atmospheric pressure
(absolute pressure)
-
-20 to +20 %
•
•
•
•
•
•
Same as SHORT FT #1
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = Lean
Stoichiometric air fuel ratio = 1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = Rich
-
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = Lean
Stoichiometric air fuel ratio = 1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = Rich
-
ON: Throttle fully closed
OFF: Throttle open
ES
ES–48
Tester Display
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SECOND AIR VSV
Secondary air injection system status
ON: Secondary air injection system
operation
FUEL PMP SP CTL
F/PMP relay status:
ON or OFF
-
Active test support data
ACIS VSV
VSV status for ACIS control:
ON or OFF
-
Active test support data
ACT VSV
A/C cut status for Active Test:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
EVAP (Purge) VSV
VSV status for EVAP control:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
FUEL PUMP / SPD
Fuel pump/speed status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
VVT CTRL B1
Variable valve timing (VVT) control
status (bank 1):
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
VVT CTRL B2
VVT control status (bank 2):
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
VACUUM PUMP
Key-off EVAP system pump status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
EVAP VENT VAL
Key-off EVAP system vent valve
status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
TC/TE1
TC and TE1 terminal of DLC3:
ON or OFF
-
-
AI STATUS
AI operation prohibit:
OK or NG
OK
-
VVTL AIM ANGL #1
VVT aim angle (bank 1):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 %: Idling
VVT duty signal value during
intrusive operation
VVTL AIM ANGL #2
VVT aim angle (bank 2):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 %: Idling
VVT duty signal value during
intrusive operation
VVTL CHAG ANGL #1
VVT change angle (bank 1):
Min.: 0° FR , Max.: 60° FR
0 to 5° FR: Idling
Displacement angle during intrusive
operation
VVT CHNG ANGL #2
VVT change angle (bank 2):
Min.: 0° FR , Max.: 60° FR
0 to 5° FR: Idling
Displacement angle during intrusive
operation
VVT OCV DUTY B1
VVT OCV operation duty (bank 1):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 %: Idling
Requested duty value for intrusive
operation
VVT OCV DUTY B2
VVT OCV operation duty (bank 2):
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 100 %
0 %: Idling
Requested duty value for intrusive
operation
FC IDL
Fuel cut idle:
ON or OFF
ON: Fuel cut operation
FC IDL = "ON" when throttle valve
fully closed and engine speed over
2800 rpm
FC TAU
Fuel cut TAU: Fuel cut during very
light load:
ON or OFF
ON: Fuel cut operation
The fuel cut being performed under
very light load to prevent the engine
combustion from becoming
incomplete
IGNITION
Ignition counter:
Min.: 0, Max.: 800
0 to 800
-
CYL #1, #2, #3, #4, #5,
#6, #7, #8
Misfire ratio of the cylinder 1 to 8:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0%
This item displayed only when idling
engine
CYL ALL
All cylinders misfire rate:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0 to 35
-
CYLS
Multiple Cylinder Misfire rate:
Min.: 0 Max.:65,535
0 to 65,535
-
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 6,375 rpm
0 rpm: Misfire 0
-
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range:
Min.: 0 g/rev, Max.: 3.98 g/rev
0 g/rev: Misfire 0
-
MISFIRE MARGIN
Misfire monitoring:
Min.: -100 %, Max.: 99.22 %
-100 to 99.2 %
Misfire detecting margin
-
ES–49
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
#CODES
#Codes:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Number of detected DTCs
CHECK MODE
Check mode:
0: ON, 1: OFF
ON: Check mode ON
See page ES-36
SPD TEST
Check mode result for vehicle speed
sensor:
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
AS TEST
Check mode result for secondary air
injection system:
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
MISFIRE TEST
Check mode result for misfire
monitor:
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
OXS1 TEST
Check mode result for heated
oxygen sensor (bank 1):
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
OXS2 TEST
Check mode result for heated
oxygen sensor (bank 2):
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
A/F SSR TEST B1
Check mode result for air fuel ratio
sensor (bank 1):
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
A/F SSR TEST B2
Check mode result for air fuel ratio
sensor (bank 2):
0: COMPL, 1: INCOMPL
-
-
MIL
MIL status:
ON or OFF
ON: MIL ON
-
MIL ON RUN DIST
MIL ON run distance:
Min.: 0 km, Max.: 65,535 km
Distance after DTC detected
-
MIL ON RUN TIME
Running time from MIL ON:
Min.: 0 minutes, Max.: 65,535
minutes
Equivalent to running time after MIL
was ON
-
ENG RUN TIME
Engine run time:
Min.: 0 seconds, Max.: 65,535
seconds
Time after engine start
Service data
TIME DTC CLEAR
Time after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0 minutes, Max.: 65,535
minutes
Equivalent to time after DTCs were
erased
-
DIST DTC CLEAR
Distance after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0 km, Max.: 65,535 km
Equivalent to drive distance after
DTCs were erased
-
WU CYC DTC CLEAR
Warm-up cycle after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Number of warm-up cycles after DTC
cleared
MODEL CODE
Model code
-
Identifying the model code:
UCK30 (2WD), UCK40 (4WD)
ENGINE TYPE
Engine type
-
Identifying the engine type:
2UZFE
CYLINDER NUMBER
Cylinder number:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Identifying the cylinder number:
8
TRANSMISSION
Transmission type
-
Identifying the transmission type:
ECT (5AT)
DESTINATION
Destination
-
Identifying the destination:
A (America)
MODEL YEAR
Model year:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Identifying the model year:
200#
SYSTEM
System identification
-
Identifying the engine system:
GASLIN (gasoline engine)
ES
ES–50
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
Normal Condition: If no conditions are specifically stated for
"idling", the shift lever is in the N or P position, and the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
2. ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV), actuator and other
items to be operated without removing any parts.
Performing the ACTIVE TEST early in troubleshooting is
one way to save time. The DATA LIST can be displayed
during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) According to the display on the tester, perform the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
Tester Display
Test Part
Control Range
Diagnostic Note
•
•
INJ VOL
Change injection volume
Between -12 % and 25 %
•
•
•
All injectors tested at the
same time
Perform test at less than
3,000 rpm
Injection volume can be
changed in 1 % graduations
within control range
Perform test at less than
3,000 rpm
A/F CONTROL enables
checking and graphing of A/F
(Air Fuel Ratio) sensor
voltage outputs
To conduct test, select
following menu items:
ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL / USER DATA /
AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2,
and press YES and ENTER
followed by F4
Change injection volume
Lower by 12.5 % or increase 25
%
•
FUEL PMP SP CTL
Fuel pump speed control
ON (low speed) / OFF (high
speed)
Test possible when following
conditions met:
• Engine switch On (IG)
• Engine is stopped
INTAKE CTL VSV1
Activate VSV for ACIS
ON/OFF
-
EVAP VSV (ALONE)
Activate purge VSV control
ON/OFF
A/F CONTROL
•
VVT CTRL B1
Turn on and off Oil Control Valve
(OCV)
VVT CTRL B2
Turn on and off Oil Control Valve
(OCV)
ON/OFF
AC CUT SIG
Control A/C cut signal
ON/OFF
-
FUEL PUMP / SPD
Activate fuel pump (C/OPN
Relay)
ON/OFF
-
ON/OFF
•
•
•
Engine stalls or idles roughly
when OCV turned ON
Normal engine running or
idling when OCV off
Engine stalls or idles roughly
when OCV turned ON
Normal engine running or
idling when OCV off
ES–51
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Display
Test Part
Control Range
Diagnostic Note
TC/TE1
Turn on and off TC and TE1
connection
ON/OFF
•
•
ON: TC and TE1 connected
OFF: TC and TE1
disconnected
FC IDL PROHBT
Prohibit idling fuel cut control
ON/OFF
-
STARTER
Active Starter relay
ON/OFF
-
ACC CUT
Active ACC cut relay
ON/OFF
Test possible when following
conditions met:
• Engine switch On (IG)
• Engine is stopped
ETCS OPEN SLOW
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve opens slowly
This test is possible when the
following conditions are met:
• Ignition switch ON
• Engine does not start
• Fully depressing accelerator
pedal (APP: 58 degrees or
more)
ETCS CLOSE SLOW
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve closes slowly
Same as above
ETCS OPEN FAST
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve opens fast
Same as above
ETCS CLOSE FAST
Throttle actuator
ON: throttle valve closes fast
Same as above
•
VVT B1
Control VVT (bank 1)
Between -128 and 127 %
•
•
VVT B2
Control VVT (bank 2)
Between -128 and 127 %
•
Engine stall or rough idle
when VVT actuator operated
by 100%
Test possible during engine
idling
Engine stall or rough idle
when VVT actuator operated
by 100%
Test possible during engine
idling
FUEL CUT #1
Cylinder #1 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
This test is possible when the
vehicle is stopped and the engine
is idling.
FUEL CUT #2
Cylinder #2 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
FUEL CUT #3
Cylinder #3 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
FUEL CUT #4
Cylinder #4 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
FUEL CUT #5
Cylinder #5 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
FUEL CUT #6
Cylinder #6 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
FUEL CUT #7
Cylinder #7 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
FUEL CUT #8
Cylinder #8 injector fuel cut
ON/OFF
Same as above
VENT VALVE (ALONE)
Activate vent valve (built into
canister pump module)
ON/OFF
-
VACUUM PUMP
Activate vacuum pump (built into
canister pump module)
ON/OFF
-
3.
SYSTEM CHECK
HINT:
Performing a SYSTEM CHECK enables the system,
which consists of multiple actuators, to be operated
without removing any parts. In addition, it can show
whether or not any DTCs are set, and can detect
potential malfunctions in the system. The SYSTEM
CHECK can be performed with the intelligent tester.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK.
ES
ES–52
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(e) Perform the SYSTEM CHECK by referring to the
table below.
Tester Display
Test Part
Control Range
Diagnostic Note
•
EVAP SYS CHECK
(AUTOMATIC)
Perform 5 steps in order to
operate EVAP key-off monitor
automatically
EVAP SYS CHECK
(MANUAL)
Perform 5 steps in order to
operate EVAP key-off monitor
manually
35°C (95°F) or less
•
AIR INJ CHECK
(AUTOMATIC)
Perform 6 steps in order to
operate air injection system
automatically
-
If no DTCs in PENDING CODES
menu after performing this test,
system functioning normally
AIR INJ CHECK
(MANUAL)
Perform 8 operations in order to
operate air injection system
monitor manually
-
Used to detect malfunctioning
parts
35°C (95°F) or less
•
•
ES
If no DTCs in PENDING
CODES menu after
performing this test, system
functioning normally
Refer to EVAP Inspection
Procedure (See page ES423)
Used to detect malfunctioning
parts
Refer to EVAP Inspection
Procedure (See page ES423)
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–53
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
The parameters listed in the chart are for reference only.
Factors such as instrument type may cause readings to differ
slightly from stated values. If any DTCs are displayed during
a check mode DTC check, check the circuit for the DTCs
listed in the table below. For details of each DTC, refer to the
page indicated.
2UZ-FE SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0010
Camshaft Position
"A" Actuator Circuit
(Bank 1)
1. Open or short in
Oil Control Valve
(OCV) (bank 1) circuit
2. Oil Control Valve
(OCV) (bank 1)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-66
P0011
Camshaft Position
"A" - Timing OverAdvanced or System
Performance (Bank
1)
1. Oil Control Valve
(OCV)
2. Valve timing
3. VVT controller
assembly
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-71
P0012
Camshaft Position
"A" - Timing OverRetarded (Bank 1)
Same as P0011
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-71
P0016
Crankshaft Position Camshaft Position
Correlation (Bank 1
Sensor A)
1. Open or short in
VVT sensor circuit
2. VVT sensor
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-76
P0018
Crankshaft Position Camshaft Position
Correlation (Bank 2
Sensor A)
Same as P0016
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-76
P0020
Camshaft Position
"A" Actuator Circuit
(Bank 2)
1. Open or short in
OCV (bank 2) circuit
2. OCV (bank 2)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-66
P0021
Camshaft Position
"A" - Timing OverAdvanced or System
Performance (Bank
2)
Same as P0011
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-71
P0022
Camshaft Position
"A" - Timing OverRetarded (Bank 2)
Same as P0011
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-71
P0031
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor
1)
1. Open in Air Fuel
Ratio (A/F) sensor
(bank 1 sensor 1)
heater circuit
2. Air Fuel Ratio (A/
F)sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 1)
3. A/F relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-79
P0032
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor
1)
1. Short in A/F sensor
(bank 1 sensor 1)
heater circuit
2. A/F sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 1)
3. A/F relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-79
ES
ES–54
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P0037
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor
2)
1. Open in Heated
Oxygen (HO2)
sensor heater circuit
2. Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-84
P0038
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor
2)
1. Short in HO2
sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-84
P0051
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor
1)
1. Open in A/F sensor
(bank 2 sensor 1)
heater circuit
2. A/F sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 1)
3. A/F relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-79
P0052
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor
1)
1. Short in A/F sensor
(bank 2 sensor 1)
heater circuit
2. A/F sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 1)
3. A/F relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-79
P0057
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor
2)
1. Open in HO2
sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-84
P0058
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor
2)
1. Short in HO2
sensor heater circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-84
P0100
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Malfunction
1. Open or short in
Mass Air Flow (MAF)
meter circuit
2. Mass Air Flow
(MAF) meter
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-92
P0101
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Range / Performance
Problem
Mass Air Flow (MAF)
meter
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-99
P0102
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Low
1. Open or short in
Mass Air Flow (MAF)
meter circuit
2. Mass Air Flow
(MAF) meter
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-92
P0103
Mass Air Flow Circuit
High
1. Open or short in
Mass Air Flow (MAF)
meter circuit
2. Mass Air Flow
(MAF) meter
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-92
ES
MIL
Memory
See page
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–55
See page
P0110
Intake Air
Temperature Circuit
1. Open or short in
Intake Air
Temperature (IAT)
sensor circuit
2. Intake Air
Temperature (IAT)
sensor (built into
MAF meter)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-102
P0111
Intake Air
Temperature Sensor
Gradient Too High
Mass air flow meter
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-107
P0112
Intake Air
Temperature Circuit
Low Input
1. Short in IAT sensor
circuit
2. IAT sensor (built
into MAF meter)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-102
P0113
Intake Air
Temperature Circuit
High Input
1. Open in IAT sensor
circuit
2. IAT sensor (built
into MAF meter)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-102
P0115
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
1. Open or short in
Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor circuit
2. Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-110
P0116
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
Range / Performance
Problem
Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-115
P0117
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
Low Input
1. Short in ECT
sensor circuit
2. ECT sensor
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-110
P0118
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
High Input
1. Open in ECT
sensor circuit
2. ECT sensor
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-110
P0120
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
1. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
2. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
P0121
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
Problem
Throttle Position (TP)
sensor (built into
throttle body)
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-126
P0122
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
Low Input
1. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
2. Short in VTA1
circuit
3. Open in VC circuit
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
ES
ES–56
DTC Code
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0123
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
High Input
1. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
2. Open in VTA1
circuit
3. Open in E2 circuit
4. Short between VC
and VTA1 circuits
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
P0125
Insufficient Coolant
Temperature for
Closed Loop Fuel
Control
1. Cooling system
2. Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
3. Thermostat
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-128
P0128
Thermostat
Malfunction
1. Thermostat
2. Cooling system
3. Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-131
P0136
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in
Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor circuit
2. Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor (bank 1
sensor 2)
3. Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 2)
4. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
5. EFI relay
6. Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-135
P0137
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Low Voltage
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Open in HO2
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank
1 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 2)
4. EFI relay
5. Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-135
P0138
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit High Voltage
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
1. Short in HO2
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank
1 sensor 2)
3. ECM internal
circuit malfunction
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-135
P0141
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in
HO2 sensor heater
circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-84
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–57
See page
P0156
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in
HO2 sensor (bank 2
sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank
2 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor2)
4. A/F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)
5. EFI relay
6. Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-135
P0157
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Low Voltage
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Open in HO2
sensor (bank 2
sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank
2 sensor 2)
3. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 2)
4. EFI relay
5. Gas leakage from
exhaust system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-135
ES
P0158
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit High Voltage
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
1. Short in HO2
sensor (bank 2
sensor 2) circuit
2. HO2 sensor (bank
2 sensor 2)
3. ECM internal
circuit malfunction
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-135
P0161
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in
HO2 sensor heater
circuit
2. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 2)
3. EFI relay
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-84
P0171
System Too Lean
(Bank 1)
1. Air induction
system
2. Injector blockage
3. Mass Air Flow
(MAF) meter
4. Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in
exhaust system
7. Open or short in
HO2 sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
8. HO2 sensor (bank
1 sensor 1)
9. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 1)
10. EFI relay
11. PCV piping
13. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-155
ES–58
DTC Code
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0172
System Too Rich
(Bank 1)
1. Injector leakage or
blockage
2. MAF meter
3. ECT sensor
4. Ignition system
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in
exhaust system
7. Open or short in
HO2 sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
8. HO2 sensor (bank
1 sensor 1)
9. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-155
P0174
System Too Lean
(Bank 2)
1. Air Induction
system
2. Injector blockage
3. MAF meter
4. ECT sensor
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in
exhaust system
7. Open or short in
HO2 sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)circuit
8. HO2 sensor (bank
2 sensor 1)
9. HO2 sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 1)
10. EFI relay
11. PCV piping
12. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-155
P0175
System Too Rich
(Bank 2)
1. Injector leakage or
blockage
2. MAF meter
3. ECT sensor
4. Ignition system
5. Fuel pressure
6. Gas leakage in
exhaust system
7. Open or short in
exhaust system
(bank 2 sensor 1)
circuit
8. HO2 sensor (bank
2 sensor 1)
9. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-155
P0220
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
1. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
2. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
P0222
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
Low Input
1. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
2. Short in VTA2
circuit
3. Open in VC circuit
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
P0223
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
High Input
1. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
2. Open in VTA2
circuit
3. Open in E2 circuit
4. Short between VC
and VTA2 circuits
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–59
See page
P0230
Fuel Pump Primary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
fuel pump relay
circuit
2. Fuel pump relay
3. Circuit opening
relay
4. Fuel pump
5. ECM
-
DTC stored
ES-168
P0300
Random / Multiple
Cylinder Misfire
Detected
1. Open or short in
engine wire harness
2. Connector
connection
3. Vacuum hose
connection
4. Ignition system
5. Fuel injector
6. Fuel pressure
7. Mass Air Flow
(MAF) meter
8. Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT)
sensor
9. Compression
pressure
10. Valve clearance
11. Valve timing
12. PCV hose
connection
13. PCV hose
14. ECM
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
ES
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0305
Cylinder 5 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0306
Cylinder 6 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0307
Cylinder 7 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0308
Cylinder 8 Misfire
Detected
Same as P0300
Comes on or blinks
DTC stored
ES-173
P0327
Knock Sensor 1
Circuit Low Input
(Bank 1 or Single
Sensor)
1. Short in knock
sensor 1 circuit
2. Knock sensor 1
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-187
P0328
Knock Sensor 1
Circuit High Input
(Bank 1 or Single
Sensor)
1. Open in knock
sensor 1 circuit
2. Knock sensor 1
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-187
P0332
Knock Sensor 2
Circuit Low Input
(Bank 2)
1. Short in knock
sensor 2 circuit
2. Knock sensor 2
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-187
P0333
Knock Sensor 2
Circuit High Input
(Bank 2)
1. Open in knock
sensor 2 circuit
2. Knock sensor 2
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-187
ES–60
DTC Code
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0335
Crankshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
1. Open or short in
Crankshaft Position
(CKP) sensor circuit
2. Crankshaft
Position (CKP)
sensor
3. Signal plate
(crankshaft position
sensor plate)
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-193
P0339
Crankshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
Intermittent
1. Open or short in
Crankshaft Position
(CKP) sensor circuit
2. Crankshaft
Position (CKP)
sensor
3. Signal plate
(crankshaft position
sensor plate)
4. ECM
-
DTC stored
ES-193
P0340
Camshaft Position
Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
1. Open or short in
camshaft position
sensor circuit
2. Camshaft position
sensor
3. Bank 1 camshaft
timing pulley
4. Timing belt has a
jumped tooth
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-198
P0341
Camshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
(Bank 1 or Single
Sensor)
Same as P0340
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-198
P0345
Camshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
(Bank 2)
Same as P0340
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-198
P0346
Camshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
(Bank 2)
Same as P0340.
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-198
P0351
Ignition Coil "A"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF1 or IGT1 circuit
between No. 1
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 1 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
P0352
Ignition Coil "B"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF2 or IGT2 circuit
between No. 2
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 2 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
P0353
Ignition Coil "C"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF2 or IGT3 circuit
between No. 3
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 3 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
ES–61
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P0354
Ignition Coil "D"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF1 or IGT4 circuit
between No. 4
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 4 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
See page
ES-203
P0355
Ignition Coil "E"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF2 or IGT5 circuit
between No. 5
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 5 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
P0356
Ignition Coil "F"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF1 or IGT6 circuit
between No. 6
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 6 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
P0357
Ignition Coil "G"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF1 or IGT7 circuit
between No. 7
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 7 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
P0358
Ignition Coil "H"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
1. Open or short in
IGF2 or IGT8 circuit
between No. 8
ignition coil and ECM
2. No. 8 ignition coil
(primary ignition)
3. Ignition system
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-203
P0412
Secondary Air
Injection System
Switching Valve "A"
Circuit
1. Open in air
switching valve drive
circuit
2. Short between air
switching valve circuit
and +B circuit
3. Short between air
switching valve circuit
and body ground
4. Air injection control
driver
5. Air switching valve
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-214
P0418
Secondary Air
Injection System
Control "A" Circuit
1. Open in air pump
drive circuit
2. Short between air
pump circuit and +B
circuit
3. Short between air
pump circuit and
body ground
4. Air injection control
driver
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-223
ES
ES–62
DTC Code
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0420
Catalyst System
Efficiency Below
Threshold (Bank 1)
1. Gas leakage from
exhaust system
2. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
3. Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor (bank 1
sensor 2)
4. Three-way
catalytic converter
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-230
P0430
Catalyst System
Efficiency Below
Threshold (Bank 2)
1. Gas leakage on
exhaust system
2. A/F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)
3. HO2 sensor (bank
2 sensor 2)
4. Three-way
catalytic converter
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-230
P043E
Evaporative Emission
System Leak
Detection Reference
Orifice Low Flow
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
3. ECM
4. Leakage from
EVAP system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-237
P043F
Evaporative Emission
System Reference
Orifice High Flow
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
3. ECM
4. Leakage from
EVAP system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-237
P0441
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Incorrect Purge Flow
1. Purge VSV
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Purge VSV
- ECM)
3. ECM
4. Pump module
5. Leakage from
EVAP system
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-243
P0450
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor
Malfunction
1. Canister pump
module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-251
P0451
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor
Range / Performance
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-251
P0452
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor /
Switch Low Input
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-251
P0453
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor /
Switch High Input
1. Pump module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-251
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
ES–63
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P0455
Evaporative Emission
Control System Leak
Detected (Gross
Leak)
1. Fuel cap (loose)
2. Leakage from
EVAP line (Canister Fuel tank)
3. Leakage from
EVAP line (Purge
VSV - canister)
4. Pump module
5. Leakage from fuel
tank
6. Leakage from
canister
Comes on
DTC stored
See page
ES-258
P0456
Evaporative Emission
Control System Leak
Detected (Very Small
Leak)
Same as P0445
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-258
P0500
Vehicle Speed
Sensor "A"
1. Combination meter
2. Open or short in
vehicle speed sensor
circuit
3. Vehicle speed
sensor
4. Skid control ECU
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-263
P0503
Vehicle Speed
Sensor "A"
Intermittent / Erratic /
High
1. Combination meter
2. Open or short in
vehicle speed sensor
circuit
3. Vehicle speed
sensor
4. Skid control ECU
5. ECM
-
DTC stored
ES-263
P0504
Brake Switch "A" / "B"
Correlation
1. Short in stop light
switch signal circuit
2. Stop light fuse
3. Stop light switch
assembly
4. ECM
-
DTC stored
ES-266
P0505
Idle Control System
Malfunction
1. ECTS
2. Air induction
system
3. Ventilation hose
connection
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-270
P050A
Cold Start Idle Air
Control System
Performance
1. ETCS
2. MAF meter
3. Air induction
system
4. Ventilation hose
connections
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-273
P050B
Cold Start Ignition
Timing Performance
1. Throttle body
2. MAF meter
3. Air induction
system
4. Ventilation hose
connections
5. VVT system
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-273
P0560
System Voltage
1. Open in back-up
power source circuit
2. EFI fuse
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-279
P0604
Random Access
Memory (RAM)
ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-284
ES
ES–64
DTC Code
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0606
ECM / PCM
Processor
1. Exhaust gas leak
2. Heated oxygen
sensor
3. ECM
Comes on/-
DTC stored
ES-285
P0607
Control Module
Performance
ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-288
P0617
Starter Relay Circuit
High
1. Starter relay circuit
2. Park/Neutral
position switch
3. Ignition switch
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-290
P0630
VIN not Programmed
or Mismatch - ECM /
PCM
ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-294
P0657
Actuator Supply
Voltage Circuit /
Open
ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-296
P1340
Camshaft Position
Sensor "A" (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
1. Open or short in
camshaft position
sensor circuit
2. Camshaft position
sensor
3. Camshaft timing
pulley LH
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-297
P1341
Camshaft Position
Sensor "A" (Bank 1
Sensor 2 )
1. Open or short in
camshaft position
sensor circuit
2. Camshaft position
sensor
3. Camshaft timing
pulley LH
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-297
P1440
Secondary Air
Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve
Circuit Malfunction
Bank 1
1. Open or short in
VSV for air injection
system (bank 1)
2. VSV power source
3. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 1)
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-301
P1441
Stuck Open in
Secondary Air
Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank
1
1. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 1)
2. No. 2 air switching
valve (bank 1)
3. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 1)
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-304
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
ES–65
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P1442
Stuck Close in
Secondary Air
Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank
1
1. VSV for air
injection system
circuit (bank 1)
2. Vacuum hose
(VSV for air injection
system - No. 2 air
switching valve)
3. Air injector pipe
(No. 2 air switching
valve - exhaust
manifold)
4. No. 2 air switching
valve (bank 1)
5. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 1)
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
See page
ES-318
P1443
Secondary Air
Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve
Circuit Malfunction
Bank 2
1. Open or short in
VSV for air injection
system circuit (bank
2)
2. VSV power source
3. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 2)
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-301
P1444
Stuck Open in
Secondary Air
Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank
2
1. VSV for air
injection system
circuit (bank 2)
2. No. 2 air switching
valve (bank 2)
3. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 2)
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-304
P1445
Stuck Close in
Secondary Air
Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank
2
1. VSV for air
injection system
circuit (bank 2)
2. Vacuum hose
(VSV for air injection
system - No. 2 air
switching valve)
3. Air injection pipe
(No. 2 air switching
valve - exhaust
manifold)
4. No. 2 air switching
valve (bank 2)
5. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 2)
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-318
ES
ES–66
DTC Code
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P1613
Secondary Air
Injection Driver
Malfunction
1. Air injection control
driver (AID)
2. Open in air
injection control
driver ground circuit
3. Short in diagnostic
information signal
circuit (AID - ECM)
4. Open or short in air
pump and air
switching valve
command signal
circuit (AID - ECM)
5. Open or short in
AID power source
circuit
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-328
P2102
Throttle Actuator
Control Motor Circuit
Low
1. Open in throttle
actuator circuit
2. Throttle actuator
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-340
P2103
Throttle Actuator
Control Motor Circuit
High
1. Short in throttle
actuator circuit
2. Throttle actuator
3. Throttle valve
4. Throttle body
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-340
P2111
Throttle Actuator
Control System Stuck Open
1. Throttle actuator
2. Throttle valve
3. Throttle body
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-343
P2112
Throttle Actuator
Control System Stuck Closed
Same as P2111
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-343
P2118
Throttle Actuator
Control Motor Current
Range / Performance
1. Open in ETCS
power source circuit
2. ETCS fuse
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-346
P2119
Throttle Actuator
Control Throttle Body
Range / Performance
1. ETCS
2. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-350
P2120
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit
1. Accelerator pedal
position (APP) sensor
2. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
P2121
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit
Range / Performance
1. APP sensor
2. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-361
P2122
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit
Low Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in VCPA
circuit
3. Open or ground
short VPA circuit
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
P2123
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit
High Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in EPA circuit
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
P2125
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit
1. APP sensor
2. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–67
See page
P2127
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit
Low Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in VCP2
circuit
3. Open or ground
short VPA2 circuit
4. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
P2128
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit
High Input
1. APP sensor
2. Open in EPA2
circuit
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
P2135
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" / "B"
Voltage Correlation
1. Short between
VTA1 and VTA2
circuit
2. Throttle Position
(TP) sensor (built into
throttle body)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-118
P2138
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "D" / "E"
Voltage Correlation
1. Short between
VPA and VPA2 circuit
2. APP sensor
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-353
P2195
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Signal Stuck Lean
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
2. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
3. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor heater (bank
1 sensor 1)
4. A/F heater relay
5. A/F sensor heater
and relay circuits
6. Air induction
system
7. Fuel pressure
8. Fuel injector
9. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-364
P2196
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Signal Stuck Rich
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as P2195
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-364
P2197
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Signal Stuck Lean
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/
F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1) circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 1)
4. A/F relay
5. A/F sensor heater
and relay circuits
6. Air induction
system
7. Fuel pressure
8. Fuel injector
9. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-364
P2198
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Signal Stuck Rich
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as P2197
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-364
P2237
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit / Open (Bank
1 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/
F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
ES
ES–68
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P2238
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
2. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
3. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor heater (bank
1 sensor 1)
4. A/F heater relay
5. A/F sensor heater
and relay circuits
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2239
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Same as P2238
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2240
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit / Open (Bank
2 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/
F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1) circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2241
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit Low (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/
F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)
3. A/F sensor heater
(bank 2 sensor 1)
4. A/F relay
5. A/F sensor heater
and relay circuit
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2242
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit High (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Same as P2241
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2252
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Reference Ground
Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Same as P2238
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2253
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Reference Ground
Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Same as P2238
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2255
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Reference Ground
Circuit Low (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Same as P2241
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2256
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Reference Ground
Circuit High (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Same as P2241
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-380
P2401
Evaporative Emission
Leak Detection Pump
Stuck OFF
1. Canister pump
module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-387
ES
MIL
Memory
See page
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
ES–69
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P2402
Evaporative Emission
Leak Detection Pump
Stuck ON
1. Canister pump
module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
See page
ES-387
P2419
Evaporative Emission
Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck ON
1. Canister pump
module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-393
P2420
Evaporative Emission
Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck OFF
1. Canister pump
module
2. Connector/Wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-393
P2430
Secondary Air
Injection System Air
Flow / Pressure
Sensor Circuit Bank1
1. Pressure sensor
2. Open or short in
pressure sensor
circuit
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-399
P2431
Secondary Air
Injection System Air
Flow / Pressure
Sensor Circuit Range
/ Performance Bank1
1. Pressure sensor
2. Open or short in
pressure sensor
circuit
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-399
P2432
Secondary Air
Injection System Air
Flow / Pressure
Sensor Circuit Low
Bank1
1. Pressure sensor
2. Open or short in
pressure sensor
circuit
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-399
P2433
Secondary Air
Injection System Air
Flow / Pressure
Sensor Circuit High
Bank1
1. Pressure sensor
2. Open or short in
pressure sensor
circuit
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-399
P2440
Secondary Air
Injection System
Switching Valve
Stuck Open Bank1
1. Air switching valve
2. No. 2 air switching
valve (bank 1 and/or
2)
3. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 1 and/or 2)
4. Air injection control
driver
5. Air injection control
driver circuit
6. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-304
ES
ES–70
DTC Code
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P2441
Secondary Air
Injection System
Switching Valve
Stuck Close Bank1
1. Vacuum hoses
(Throttle body - VSVs
for air injection
system)
2. Air switching valve
3. Air injection pipe
(No. 2 air switching
valve - exhaust
manifold)
4. Air injection hose
5. No. 2 air switching
valve (bank 1 and/or
2)
6. VSV for air
injection system
(bank 1 and/or 2)
7. Air injection control
driver
8. Air injection control
driver circuit
9. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-318
P2444
Secondary Air
Injection System
Pump Stuck On
Bank1
1. Short in air pump
circuit
2. Pressure sensor
3. Air injection control
driver
4. Open or short in
pressure sensor
circuit
5. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-403
P2445
Secondary Air
Injection System
Pump Stuck Off
Bank1
1. Air pump fuse
2. Vacuum hose
3. Air pump assembly
4. Air injection control
driver
5. Open in air pump
circuit
6. Air injection
system piping
7. Pressure sensor
8. Open or short in
pressure sensor
circuit
9. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-403
P2610
ECM / PCM Internal
Engine Off Timer
Performance
ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-413
P2A00
A/F Sensor Circuit
Slow Response
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
2. Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-415
P2A03
A/F Sensor Circuit
Slow Response
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
1. Open or short in A/
F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1) circuit
2. A/F sensor (bank 2
sensor 1)
3. ECM
Comes on
DTC stored
ES-415
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–1
SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
Perform the RESET MEMORY (AT initialization) when
replacing the automatic transmission assembly, engine
assembly or ECM.
HINT:
Initialization cannot be completed by only removing the
battery.
ES
ES–2
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Terms
Definitions
Monitor description
Description of what the ECM monitors and how it detects malfunctions (monitoring purpose
and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by ECM based on same malfunction
detection logic.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow ECM to detect malfunctions. With all preconditions satisfied, ECM
sets DTC when monitored value(s) exceeds malfunction threshold(s).
Sequence of operation
Order of monitor priority, applied if multiple sensors and components are involved in single
malfunction detection process. Each sensor and component monitored in turn and not
monitored until previous detection operation completed.
Required sensor/components
Sensors and components used by ECM to detect each malfunction.
Frequency of operation
Number of times ECM checks for each malfunction during each driving cycle. "Once per
driving cycle" means ECM only performs checks for that malfunction once during single
driving cycle. "Continuous" means ECM performs checks for that malfunction whenever
enabling conditions are met.
Duration
Minimum time for which ECM must detect continuous deviation in monitored value(s) in
order to set DTC. Timing begins when Typical Enabling Conditions are met.
Malfunction thresholds
Value beyond which ECM determines malfunctions exist and sets DTCs.
MIL operation
Timing of MIL illumination after malfunction detected. "Immediate" means ECM illuminates
MIL as soon as malfunction detected. "2 driving cycle" means ECM illuminates MIL if same
malfunction detected second time during next sequential driving cycle.
ES
ES–71
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0010
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator Circuit (Bank
1)
DTC
P0020
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator Circuit (Bank
2)
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
These DTCs relate to the Oil Control Valve (OCV).
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system includes the ECM, Oil Control Valve (OCV) and VVT controller.
The ECM sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal regulates the oil
pressure supplied to the VVT controller. Camshaft timing control is performed according to engine
operating conditions such as intake air volume, throttle valve position and engine coolant temperature.
The ECM controls the OCV, based on the signals transmitted by several sensors. The VVT controller
regulates the intake camshaft angle using oil pressure through the OCV. As a result, the relative positions
of the camshaft and crankshaft are optimized, the engine torque and fuel economy improve, and the
exhaust emissions decrease under overall driving conditions. The ECM detects the actual intake valve
timing using signals from the camshaft and crankshaft position sensors, and performs feedback control.
This is how the target intake valve timing is verified by the ECM.
ECM
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Duty Control
Target Valve Timing
Mass Air Flow Meter
Throttle Position Sensor
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
Feedback
Correction
Camshaft Timing
Oil Control Valve
(OCV)
Vehicle Speed Signal
Camshaft Position Sensor
Actual Valve Timing
A117755E01
DTC No.
P0010
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in Oil Control Valve (OCV) (bank 1)
circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in Oil Control Valve (OCV) (bank 1)
circuit
Oil Control Valve (OCV) (bank 1)
ECM
ES
ES–72
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
P0020
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in OCV (bank 2) circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in OCV (bank 2) circuit
OCV (bank 2)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
After the ECM sends the "target" duty-cycle signal to the OCV (Oil Control Valve), the ECM monitors the
OCV current to establish an "actual" duty-cycle. When the actual duty-cycle ratio varies from the target
duty-cycle, the ECM sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0010: OCV (bank 1) range check
P0020: OCV (bank 2) range check
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
VVT OCV
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Starter
OFF
Ignition switch
ON
Time after ignition switch OFF to ON
0.5 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
One of the following conditions is met
Condition A, B or C
A. All of the following conditions are met
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
a. Battery voltage
11 V or more, and less than 13 V
b. Target duty ratio
Less than 70 %
c. Output signal duty ratio
100 % or more
B. All of the following conditions are met
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
a. Battery voltage
13 V or more
b. Target duty ratio
Less than 80 %
c. Output signal duty ratio
100 % or more
C. Both of the following conditions are met
Condition (a) and (b)
a. Current cut status
Not cut
b. Output signal duty ratio
3 % or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty for OCV
More than 3 %, and less than 100 %
ES–73
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
C2
OCV (Bank 1)
ECM
1
17
P
E6 OC1+
2
LG
16
E6 OC1-
1
R-W
15
E6 OC2+
2
Y-R
14
E6 OC2-
C3
OCV (Bank 2)
ES
A115908E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTC P0010 is displayed, check the bank 1 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
• If DTC P0020 is displayed, check the bank 2 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
• Read freeze frame data using a intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OCV OPERATION)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and warm it up.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1 or VVT CTRL
B2.
(e) Operate the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and check the
engine condition at idling.
OK
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Engine idles roughly or stalls (soon after OCV switched from OFF to ON)
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–74
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
2
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY (OPERATION)
Battery (-)
Battery (+)
Valve
(a) Disconnect the C13 or C14 OCV connectors.
(b) Apply battery voltage to the terminals of the OCV.
(c) Check the engine speed.
OK:
Rough idle or engine stalled.
(d) Reconnect the OCV connectors.
NG
ES
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
A088857E03
OK
3
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
ECM Connector
E6
(a) Inspect the ECM using an oscilloscope.
(b) While idling the engine, check the waveform of the E6
ECM connector using an oscilloscope.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
OC1+ (E6-17) - OC1- (E6-16)
OC2+ (E6-15) - OC2- (E6-14)
OC1+ OC1- OC2+ OC2-
NG
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/DIV.
GND
200 msec./DIV.
G035623E17
OK
REPLACE ECM
Specified Condition
Correct waveform is as shown
ES–75
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (OCV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the C2 or C3 OCV connectors.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
OCV Connector
C2
Tester Connection
Specified condition
OCV (C2-1) - OC1+ (E6-17)
C3
OCV (C2-2) - OC1- (E6-16)
Front View
OCV (C3-1) - OC2+ (E6-15)
Below 1 Ω
OCV (C3-2) - OC2- (E6-14)
E6
ECM Connector
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified condition
OCV (C2-1) or OC1+ (E6-17) - Body
ground
E1
OC1+
OC1-
OCV (C2-2) or OC1- (E6-16) - Body
ground
OC2-
OCV (C3-1) or OC2+ (E6-15) - Body
ground
OC2+
10 kΩ or higher
OCV (C3-2) or OC2- (E6-14) - Body
ground
A115689E02
(d) Reconnect the OCV connectors.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–76
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0011
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Advanced
or System Performance (Bank 1)
DTC
P0012
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Retarded
(Bank 1)
DTC
P0021
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Advanced
or System Performance (Bank 2)
DTC
P0022
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Retarded
(Bank 2)
ES
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Refer to DTC P0010 (See page ES-66).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0011
P0021
Advanced cam timing:
After engine is warmed up and engine speed is at 400 to
4,000 rpm, condition (a) continues (1 trip detection logic):
(a) Valve timing does not change from current valve
timing
P0012
P0022
Retarded cam timing:
After engine is warmed up and engine speed is at 400 to
4,000 rpm, condition (a) continues (2 trip detection logic):
(a) Valve timing does not change from current valve
timing
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Oil Control Valve (OCV)
Valve timing
OCV filter
VVT controller assembly
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system to control the intake
valve camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the OCV and the VVT actuator. The ECM sends a
target "duty-cycle" control signal to the OCV. This control signal, applied to the OCV, regulates the oil
pressure supplied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake valve
camshaft.
Example:
A DTC will set if: 1) the difference between the target and actual valve timing is more than 5° of the
Crankshaft Angle (CA) and the condition continues for more than 4.5 sec.; or 2) the OCV is forcibly
activated 63 times or more.
Advanced cam DTCs are subject to 1 trip detection logic.
Retarded cam DTCs are subject to 2 trip detection logic.
The monitor runs if all the conditions below are met:
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0011: Advance camshaft timing (bank 1)
P0012: Retard camshaft timing (bank 2)
P0021: Advance camshaft timing (bank 1)
P0022: Retard camshaft timing (bank 2)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
VVT OCV and VVT actuator
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor, Camshaft position sensor, Crankshaft
position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
ES–77
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL Operation
P0011 and P0021: Immediate
P0012 and P0022: 2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0351 - P0358 (igniter)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine RPM
400 to 4,000 rpm
ECT
75 to 100°C (167 to 212°F)
ES
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Advance:
Both of the following conditions are met
-
(a) Deviation of valve timing
More than 5° CA (crankshaft angle)
(b) Valve timing
No change at advanced valve timing
Retarded:
Both of the following conditions are met
-
(a) Deviation of valve timing
More than 5° CA (crankshaft angle)
(b) Valve timing
No change at retarded valve timing
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0010 (See page ES-68).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Abnormal bank
Advanced timing over
(Valve timing is out of specified range)
Retarded timing over
(Valve timing is out of specified range)
Bank 1
P0011
P0012
Bank 2
P0021
P0022
• If DTC P0011 or P0012 is displayed, check the bank 1 Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system circuit.
• If DTC P0021 or P0022 is displayed, check the bank 2 VVT system circuit.
• Bank 1 includes No. 1 cylinder, but bank 2 does not. No. 1 cylinder is located in the front part of the
engine, opposite the transmission.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OCV OPERATION)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and warm it up.
ES–78
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1 or VVT CTRL
B2.
(d) Using the intelligent tester, operate the Oil Control Valve
(OCV) and check the engine speed.
Standard
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
HINT:
DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is also output when a
foreign object is detected in some parts of the system in the
engine oil, and then the system returns to normal in a short
time. As the ECM is controlled to eject a foreign object, there
is no problem with the VVT. There is also no problem with the
VVT as the oil filter should catch the foreign object in the
engine oil.
ES
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK
NG
2
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE AND JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING BELT)
(a) Check the valve timing (See page EM-16).
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (OCV-ECM)
OCV Signal Waveform
5V /
Division
A
A
A
GND
NG
200 msec. / Division
E6
OC1+
OC1-
(a) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
(b) During idling, check the waveform between the specified
terminals of the E6 ECM connector.
HINT:
The waveform frequency (A) is lengthened as the engine
speed becomes higher.
Standard:
The correct waveform is as shown.
ECM Connector
E1
OC2OC2+
A115690E01
REPLACE ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–79
OK
4
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Ohmmeter
A115691E01
(a) Remove the V-bank cover.
(b) Remove the air cleaner inlet and intake air connector.
(c) Disconnect the C13 and C14 Oil Control Valve (OCV)
connectors.
(d) Measure the resistance of the OCV.
Standard resistance:
6.9 to 7.9 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(e) Reconnect the OCV connector.
(f) Reinstall the air cleaner inlet and intake air connector.
(g) Reinstall the V-bank cover.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
OK
5
INSPECT VVT CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
A115692
Remove the timing belt (See page EM-16).
Remove the cylinder head cover.
Remove the OCV.
Drain the oil in the VVT controller assembly.
Check whether the oil in VVT controller assembly is
drained or not.
Standard:
The oil in VVT controller assembly is drained.
(f) Reinstall the OCV.
(g) Reinstall the cylinder head cover.
(h) Reinstall the timing belt.
OK
NG
6
NEXT
REPLACE VVT CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY
Go to step 7
ES
ES–80
7
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
(a) Remove the cylinder head cover (See page EM-107).
(b) Remove the camshaft bearing cap and OCV filter.
(c) Check that the filter is not clogged.
OK:
The filter is not clogged.
(d) Reinstall the camshaft bearing cap and OCV filter.
(e) Reinstall the cylinder head cover.
NG
CLEAN OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
A086178E01
ES
OK
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 OR P0022)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM.
Then connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Clear DTCs.
(d) Start the engine and warm it up.
(e) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the tester.
(f) Drive the vehicle for more than 10 minutes.
(g) Read output DTCs using the tester.
Standard:
No DTC output.
HINT:
DTC P0011 or P0012 is output when foreign objects in
engine oil are caught in some parts of the system. These
codes will stay registered even if the system returns to
normal after a short time. These foreign objects are then
captured by the oil filter, thus eliminating the source of
the problem.
OK
NG
REPLACE ECM
SYSTEM OK
ES–81
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0016
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation (Bank 1 Sensor A)
DTC
P0018
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation (Bank 2 Sensor A)
DESCRIPTION
VVT sensor (VVL or VVR signal) consist of a signal plate and pickup coil.
The VVL or VVR signal plate has 1 tooth on its outer circumference and is mounted on the intake
camshafts.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating an electromotive force in the pickup coil.
The actual camshaft angle is detected by the VVT sensor and it provides feedback to the ECM to control
the intake valve timing in response to during condition.
DTC No.
P0016
P0018
DTC Detection Condition
Deviation in crankshaft and camshaft position sensor
signals
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing by using the VVT (Variable Valve Timing) system to control the intake
camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The
ECM sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal applied to the OCV, regulates
the oil pressure supplied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake valve
camshaft. The ECM calibrates the intake valve timing by setting the intake camshaft to the most retarded
angle while the engine is idling. The ECM closes the OCV to retard the cam. The ECM stores this value
as the VVT learning value. When the difference between the target and actual intake valve timings is
5°CA (Crankshaft Angle) or less, the ECM stores it.
If the VVT learning value matches the following conditions, the ECM determines the existence of a
malfunction in the VVT system, and sets the DTC.
• VVT learning value: Less than 22.5°CA (Crankshaft Angle), or more than 44°CA (47.5°CA).
• Above condition continues for 18 seconds or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0016: Camshaft timing (bank 1) misalignment
P0018: Camshaft timing (bank 2) misalignment
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
VVT actuator
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Camshaft position sensor, Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 60 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0011 (VVT system 1 - advance)
P0012 (VVT system 1 - retard)
P0021 (VVT system 2 - advance)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
Engine speed
400 to 1,400 rpm
ES
ES–82
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
One of the following conditions is met
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) VVT learning value at maximum retarded valve timing
Less than 22.5°CA (crankshaft angle)
(b) VVT learning value at maximum retarded valve timing
bank 1: More than 44°CA (crankshaft angle)
bank 2: More than 47.5°CA (crankshaft angle)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ES
V4
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
ECM
Shielded
1
R
18
VV2+
E6
2
G
28
VV2E6
V3
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
Shielded
1
Y
25
VV1+
E6
2
L
24
VV1E6
W-B
W-B
E
J28
J/C
E
ED
A130711E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTC P0016 is displayed, check left bank VVT sensor.
• If DTC P0018 is displayed, check right bank VVT sensor.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–83
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester or OBD II scan tool. Because the ECU records
vehicle and driving condition information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When
troubleshooting, freeze frame data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or
stopped, whether the engine was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well
as other data recorded at the time of malfunction.
1
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE AND JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING BELT)
(a) Check valve timing (See page EM-16).
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–84
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0031
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0032
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0051
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0052
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
ES
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-364).
HINT:
• Although the DTC titles refer to the "oxygen sensor", these DTCs relate to the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor.
• The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust the current through the heater. The
A/F sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
A/F HEATER
A/F Sensor
ECM
A/F Heater Fuse
From
Battery
Heater
+B
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
Sensor
AF-
A1A-
Duty
Control
From EFI Relay
A118002E16
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0031
P0051
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater current less than 0.8 A
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Open in Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater circuit
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater
A/F relay
ECM
P0032
P0052
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater current more than 10 A
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Short in A/F sensor heater circuit
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–85
HINT:
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes No. 1 cylinder.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include No. 1 cylinder.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses information from the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor to regulate the air fuel ratio and keep it
close to the stoichiometric level. This maximizes the ability of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) to
purify the exhaust gases.
The A/F sensor detects oxygen levels in the exhaust gas and transmits the information to the ECM. The
inner surface of the sensor element is exposed to the outside air. The outer surface of the sensor element
is exposed to the exhaust gas. The sensor element is made of platinum coated zirconia and includes an
integrated heating element.
The zirconia element generates a small voltage when there is a large difference in the oxygen
concentrations between the exhaust gas and outside air. The platinum coating amplifies this voltage
generation.
The A/F sensor is more efficient when heated. When the exhaust gas temperature is low, the sensor
cannot generate useful voltage signals without supplementary heating. The ECM regulates the
supplementary heating using a duty-cycle approach to adjust the average current in the sensor heater
element. If the heater current is outside the normal range, the signal transmitted by the A/F sensor will be
inaccurate. As a result, the ECM will be unable to regulate air fuel ratio properly.
When the current in the A/F sensor heater is outside the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this
as a malfunction in the sensor heater and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0031: A/F sensor heater (bank 1) range check (low current)
P0032: A/F sensor heater (bank 1) range check (high current)
P0051: A/F sensor heater (bank 2) range check (low current)
P0052: A/F sensor heater (bank 2) range check (high current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor heater
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
None
P0031 and P0051 (Low current):
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
A/F sensor heater duty ratio
50 % or more
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
P0032 and P0052 (High current):
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0031 and P0051 (Low current):
A/F sensor heater current
Less than 0.8 A
ES
ES–86
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0032 and P0052 (High Current):
A/F sensor heater current
More than 10 A
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
P0031 and P0051:
A/F sensor heater current
1.8 to 3.4 A at 20°C (68°F)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-368).
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 and A13 Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor connectors.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor
A12
A13
HT
+B
AF-
AF+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 Ω to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connectors.
Front View
A085152E60
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2
INSPECT A/F RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the A/F relay.
NG
REPLACE A/F RELAY
ES–87
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (HA1A OR HA2A VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
E5
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the E5 ECM connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
HA1A (E5-2) - Body ground
HA2A (E5-1) - Body ground
HA2A
HA1A
E118245E20
9 to 14 V
HINT:
• The HA1A means the A/F sensor bank 1 sensor 1.
• The HA2A means the A/F sensor bank 2 sensor 1.
OK
NG
Specified Condition
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–88
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM, A/F SENSOR - A/F RELAY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side:
A/F Sensor Connector
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
HT
+B
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
A12
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A13
ES
Tester Connection
Front View
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body
ground
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body
ground
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
(e) Remove A/F relay from engine room R/B.
(f) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
Tester Connection
HA2A
HA1A
ECM Connector
+B (A12-2) - A/F relay (3)
+B (A13-2) - A/F relay (3)
Engine Room R/B:
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
+B (A12-2) or A/F relay (3) - Body
ground
+B (A13-2) or A/F relay (3) - Body
ground
A/F Sensor Heater Relay
A137813E01
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reinstall the A/F relay from engine room R/B.
(h) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(i) Reconnect the A/F sensor connectors.
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0037
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit Low
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0038
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit High
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0057
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit Low
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0058
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit High
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0141
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0161
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
ES–89
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted behind the Three-Way Catalyst Converter (TWC) and located far
from the engine assembly.
In order to obtain a high purification rate of the carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and nitrogen
oxide (NOx) components in the exhaust gas, a TWC is used. For the most efficient use of the TWC, the air
fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air fuel level. For the
purpose of helping the ECM to deliver accurate air fuel ratio control, a Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor is
used.
The HO2 sensor is located behind the TWC, and detects the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas.
Since the sensor is integrated with the heater that heats the sensing portion, it is possible to detect the
oxygen concentration even when the intake air volume is low (the exhaust gas temperature is low).
When the air fuel ratio becomes lean, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas is rich. The HO2
sensor informs the ECM that the post-TWC air fuel ratio is lean (low voltage, i.e. less than 0.45 V).
Conversely, when the air fuel ratio is richer than the stoichiometric air fuel level, the oxygen concentration
in the exhaust gas becomes lean. The HO2 sensor has the property of changing its output voltage
drastically when the air fuel ratio is close to the stoichiometric level.
The ECM uses the supplementary information from the HO2 sensor to determine whether the air fuel ratio
after the TWC is rich or lean, and adjusts the fuel injection time accordingly. Thus, if the HO2 sensor is
working improperly due to internal malfunctions, the ECM is unable to compensate for deviations in the
primary air fuel ratio control.
ES
ES–90
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Ideal Air Fuel Mixture
Atmosphere Air
Housing
Output Voltage
Platinum Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Heater
ES
Coating (Ceramic)
Cover
Richer - Air Fuel Ratio - Leaner
Exhaust Gas
A115539E02
HINT:
The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust the current through the heater. The
heated oxygen sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 2)
ECM
Heated Oxygen Sensor
EFI
EFI Fuse
EFI No. 2 Fuse
Heater
HT1B
From
Battery
Sensor
OX1B
Duty
Control
E2
MREL
Ground
A137814E04
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
P0037
P0057
Heater current is 0.25 A or less when the heater operates
with more than 10.5 V positive battery voltage
•
•
•
Open in Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater
circuit
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater
EFI Relay
ECM
ES–91
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0038
P0058
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 2.0 A (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
P0141
P0161
Cumulative heater resistance correction value exceeds
threshold (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
HO2 sensor heater
EFI Relay
ECM
Open or short in HO2 sensor heater circuit
HO2 sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
HINT:
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes No. 1 cylinder.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include No. 1 cylinder.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The sensing portion of the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor has a zirconia element which is used to detect
the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas. If the zirconia element is at the appropriate temperature,
and the difference between the oxygen concentration surrounding the inside and outside surfaces of the
sensor is large, the zirconia element generates voltage signals. In order to increase the oxygen
concentration detecting capacity of the zirconia element, the ECM supplements the heat from the exhaust
with heat from a heating element inside the sensor.
Heated oxygen sensor heater range check (P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058):
The ECM monitors the current applied to the O2 sensor heater to check the heater for malfunctions. If the
current is below the threshold value, the ECM determines that there is an open circuit in the heater. If the
current is above the threshold value, the ECM determines that there is a short circuit in the heater.
The ECM constantly monitors the current applied to the heater. IF the ECM detects an open or short
circuit, the ECM turns the MIL on and sets a DTC.
If a malfunction is detected, the ECM cuts off the current applied to the heater.
Example:
The ECM sets DTC P0038 or P0058 when the current in the HO2 sensor heater is more than 2 A.
Conversely, when the heater current is less than 0.3 A, DTC P0037 or P0057 is set.
Heated oxygen sensor heater performance (P0141 and P0161):
After the accumulated heater ON time exceeds 100 seconds, the ECM calculates the heater resistance
using the battery voltage and the current applied to the heater.
If the resistance is above the threshold value, the ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the HO2
sensor heater and sets DTC P0141 or P0161.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0037: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1) range check (low
current)
P0038: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1) range check (high
current)
P0057: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2) range check (low
current)
P0058: Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2) range check (high
current)
P0141: Heated oxygen sensor heater performance (bank 1)
P0161: Heated oxygen sensor heater performance (bank 2)
Required sensors / components
Heated oxygen sensor heater
Required sensors / components
Vehicle speed sensor (VSS)
Frequency of operation
Continuous: P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058
Once per driving cycle: P0141 and P0161
Duration
1 second: P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058
10 seconds: P0141 and P0161
MIL operation
Immediate: P0037, P0038, P0057 and P0058
2 driving cycle: P0141 and P0161
ES
ES–92
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
P0037 and P0057 (Low current):
ES
duration of the following conditions are met:
0.5 seconds or more
(a) Time after heaters are OFF
1 second or more
(b) Following conditions are met
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more to less than 20 V
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
Intrusive heating
Not operating
Heater is OFF
Less than 0.1 seconds
Heater current
Less than 0.3 A
P0038 and P0058 (High current):
When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) When all conditions are met:
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Starter
OFF
Catalyst monitoring active A/F control
Not operating
Active heater OFF control
Not operating
Active heater ON control
Not operating
(b) When all conditions below are met:
-
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more to less than 20 V
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
Active heater OFF control
Not operating
Active heater On control
Not operating
Heater OFF time
Less than 0.1 seconds
Heater current
2 A or more
(c) Heater OFF time
1 second or more
P0141 and P0161
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Fuel cut
OFF
Time after fuel cut ON to OFF
30 seconds or more
Accumulated heater ON time
100 seconds or more
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0037 and P0057 (Low current):
Heater current - Learned heater OFF current
Less than 0.3 A
P0038 and P0058 (High current):
When either condition below is met:
Condition A or B
A. Learned heater OFF current
More than 2 A
B. Heater current - Learned heater OFF current
5 A or more
P0141 and P0161
Heater resistance
Varies with sensor element temperature (example: More than 23 Ω)
ES–93
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
HO2S heater current
0.4 to 1 A (at idle, warmed-up engine and +B: 11 to 14 V)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B
ECM
EFI Relay
W-B
2
L
2
1
5
3
2
35
IC4
W-G
2
2
Engine Room R/B
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
B
L-W 2
EFI No. 2
2
J28
J/C
J4
J/C
L-W
A
17
L-W
IC3
2
1
W
33
E5 OX2B
D
H6
Heated Oxygen
Sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
C D
L-W
L-W
EFI
5
E5 HT2B
P
BR
E1 OX
4
3
12
L-W
IM1
C
C
Engine
Room R/B
1
(Shielded)
1
L-W
2
+B HT
2
2
A
8
E8 MREL
W-G
2
+B HT
1
G-Y
(Shielded)
BR
E1 OX
4
3
B
1
E4 HT1B
18
E4 OX1B
2
28
E4 E2
BR
J2 B
J/C
E
J28
J/C
B
J3 B
W-B
E
W-B
EB
E
1
E6 E1
W-B
Battery
ED
EE
A131128E01
ES
ES–94
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the HO2 sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
HO2 Sensor
ES
+B
HT
H6
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connectors.
H8
NG
E1
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OX
A137828E02
OK
2
INSPECT EFI RELAY
(a) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E03
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
OK
Terminal Connection
REPLACE EFI RELAY
ES–95
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
INSPECT ECM (HT1B OR HT2B VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
E4
E5
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the E4 and E5 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
Terminal Connection
HT1B (E4-1) - Body ground
HT2B (E5-5) - Body ground
HT1B
HT2B
E118245E21
9 to 14 V
HINT:
• The HT1B means the heated oxygen sensor bank 1
sensor 2.
• The HT2B means the heated oxygen sensor bank 2
sensor 2.
OK
NG
Specified Condition
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–96
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR - EFI RELAY, HEATED
OXYGEN SENSOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side:
Heated Oxygen Sensor Connector
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the H6 or H8 oxygen sensor connectors.
Disconnect the E4 and E5 ECM connectors.
Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
H6 Bank 1
+B
H8 Bank 2
HT
E4
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
HT (H8-1) - HT2B (E5-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Front View
ES
Terminal Connection
HT (H6-1) - HT1B (E4-1)
E5
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
HT (H6-1) or HT1B (E4-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (H8-1) or HT2B (E5-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(e) Remove EFI relay from engine room R/B.
(f) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
HT2B
+B (H6-2) - EFI relay (3)
ECM Connector
HT1B
+B (H8-2) - EFI relay (3)
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connection
+B (H8-2) or EFI relay (3) - Body
ground
EFI Relay
A137829E01
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the ECM connectors.
(h) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connectors.
(i) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
REPLACE ECM
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
+B (H6-2) or EFI relay (3) - Body
ground
OK
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–97
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0100
Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P0102
Mass Air Flow Circuit Low
DTC
P0103
Mass Air Flow Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
The Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM
uses this information to determine the fuel injection time and provide a proper air fuel ratio. Inside the
MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire exposed to the flow of intake air.
By applying a specific current to the wire, the ECM heats this wire to a given temperature. The flow of
incoming air cools the wire and an internal thermistor, affecting their resistance. To maintain a constant
current value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components in the MAF meter. The voltage
level is proportional to the air passing through the sensor. The ECM interprets this voltage as the intake air
amount.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire and temperature sensor provide a bridge circuit,
with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of A and B remains equal to maintain the set
temperature.
B+
Temperature Sensor
Platinum Hot Wire (Heater)
Power Transistor
Platinum Hot Wire (Heater)
A
B
Output Voltage
Temperature Sensor
G032710E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0100
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit with more than
3 seconds engine speed 4,000 rpm or less
•
•
•
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0102
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit with more than
3 seconds engine speed 4,000 rpm or less
•
•
•
•
Open in mass air flow meter circuit
Short in ground circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0103
Open in mass air flow meter circuit with more than 3
seconds (E2G circuit) engine speed 4,000 rpm or less
Short in mass air flow meter circuit with more than 3
seconds (+B circuit) engine speed 4,000 rpm or less
•
•
•
•
Open in mass air flow meter circuit (E2G circuit)
Short in mass air flow meter circuit (+B circuit)
Mass air flow meter
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0100, P0102 or P0103, use the intelligent tester to confirm the MAF ratio from the
ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
Mass Air Flow Rate (g/sec.)
Approximately 0.0
271.0 or more
Malfunction
•
•
MAF meter power source circuit open
VG circuit open or short
E2G circuit open
ES
ES–98
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is a defect in the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter or an open or short circuit, the voltage level will
deviate outside the normal operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a defect in the MAF
meter and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the sensor output voltage is less than 0.2 V or more than 4.9 V and if either condition continues for
more than 3 seconds, the ECM will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0100: MAF meter range check (fluttering)
P0102: MAF meter range check (low voltage)
P0103: MAF meter range check (high voltage)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
MAF meter
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate: Engine RPM is less than 4,000 rpm
2 driving cycles: Engine RPM is 4,000 rpm or more
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
None
The typical enabling condition is not available
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0100:
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V or more than 4.9 V
P0102:
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V
P0103:
MAF meter voltage
More than 4.9 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
MAF meter voltage
Between 0.4 and 2.2 V
ES–99
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B
ECM
EFI Relay
L
J/C
2
2
EFI
2
2
3
8
MREL
E8
B
B
J2
W-G
W-B
2
2
B J3
2
1
IC4 35
EFI No. 2
J4
J/C
1
5
A
L-W
2
2
W-G
2
1
A
2
Engine
Room R/B
ES
L-W
M1
Mass Air Flow Meter
17 IC3
B
L-W
W-B
12
L-W
IM1
C
L-W 1 +B
C
J28
J/C
Battery
VG 3 W-R
30
VG
E4
E2G 2 B-W
29
E2G
E4
EB
A131129E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MASS AIR FLOW RATE)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / MAF.
(d) Read the values displayed on the tester.
Result
Mass Air Flow Rate (g/sec.)
Proceed to
0.0
A
271.0 or more
B
Between 1.0 and 270.0 (*1)
C
ES–100
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
*1: The value must change when the throttle valve is open or
closed.
B
C
Go to step 6
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
INSPECT MASS AIR FOW METER (POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE)
Wire Harness Side
MAF Meter Connector
ES
M1
+B (+)
(a) Disconnect the M1 Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
+B (M1-1) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
A054396E48
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (VG VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
E4
VG (+) E2G (-)
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Measure the voltage of the E4 ECM connector.
HINT:
Move the shift lever to P or N and turn the A/C switch
OFF.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
VG (E4-30) - E2G (E429)
Engine is idling
0.5 to 3.0 V
E118245E22
OK
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES–101
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - ECM)
Wire Harness Side
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
VG (M1-3) - VG (E4-30)
Below 1 Ω
E2G (M1-2) - E2G (E4-29)
Below 1 Ω
VG (M1-3) or VG (E4-30) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
M1
E2G
E4
Front View
VG
Specified Condition
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the MAF connector.
ECM Connector
NG
E2G
VG
A115696E02
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–102
5
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - EFI RELAY)
(a) Remove the EFI No. 2 fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance in the EFI No. 2 fuse.
Standard:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the EFI No. 2 fuse.
(d) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
(e) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room R/B.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
+B (+)
M1
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
Front View
ES
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
+B (M1-1) - Engine room R/B (EFI
relay terminal 3)
Below 1 Ω
+B (M1-1) or Engine room R/B (EFI
relay terminal 3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
(h) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
EFI Relay
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
A137830E01
OK
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
6
INSPECT ECM (SENSOR GROUND)
ECM Connector
(a) Measure the resistance of the ECM connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E2G (E4-29) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E4
NG
E2G
E118245E23
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES–103
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
Tester Connection
M1
E2G
VG
Front View
VG (M1-3) - VG (E4-30)
Below 1 Ω
E2G (M1-2) - E2G (E4-29)
Below 1 Ω
VG (M1-3) or VG (E4-30) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
E2G (M1-2) or E2G (E4-29) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
E4
NG
VG
Specified Condition
E2G
ECM Connector
A137865E01
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–104
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0101
Mass Air Flow Circuit Range / Performance
Problem
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0100 (See page ES-92).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0101
Conditions (a), (b), (c), (d) and (e) are met (2 trip detection
logic):
(a) Engine running
(b) Engine coolant temperature 70°C (158°F) or higher
(c) Throttle Position (TP) sensor voltage 0.24 V or more
(d) Average engine load value ratio less than 0.85, or more
than 1.92 (varies with estimated engine load)
Average engine load value ratio = Average engine load based
on MAF meter output / Average engine load estimated from
driving conditions
(e) Average air-fuel ratio less than -20%, or more than 20%
ES
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Air induction system
PCV hose connections
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The MAF meter is a sensor that measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM
uses this information to determine the fuel injection time and to provide an appropriate air-fuel ratio. Inside
the MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire which is exposed to the flow of intake air. By applying a
specific electrical current to the wire, the ECM heats it to a specific temperature. The flow of incoming air
cools both the wire and an internal thermistor, affecting their resistance. To maintain a constant current
value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components of the MAF meter. The voltage level is
proportional to the airflow through the sensor, and the ECM uses it to calculate the intake air volume.
The ECM monitors the average engine load value ratio to check the MAF meter for malfunctions. The
average engine load value ratio is obtained by comparing the average engine load calculated from the
MAF meter output to the average engine load estimated from the driving conditions, such as the engine
speed and the throttle opening angle. If the average engine load value ratio is below the threshold value,
the ECM determines that the intake air volume is low, and if the average engine load value ratio is above
the threshold value, the ECM determines that the intake air volume is high.
If this is detected in 2 consecutive driving cycles, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0101: MAF Meter Rationality (low voltage)
P0101: MAF Meter Rationality (high voltage)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
MAF meter
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine speed sensor, Engine coolant temperature sensor, Throttle position
sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ALL:
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
Throttle position
0.24 V or more
Engine
Running
ES–105
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine coolant temperature
70°C (158°F) or more
IAT sensor circuit
Not detected
ECT sensor circuit
Not detected
CKP sensor circuit
Not detected
TP sensor circuit
Not detected
Canister pressure sensor circuit
Not detected
Leak detection pump fail
Not detected
Vent valve fail
Not detected
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Average lode value ratio
Less than 0.85% or more than 1.92%
Average air-fuel ratio
Less than -20% or more than 20
ES
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0100 (see page ES-94).
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the mass air flow performance monitor.
Vehicle Speed
Approximately 62 mph
(100 km/h)
Idling
Time
Warming Up
20 seconds or more
A112632E01
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-35).
Start the engine, and warm it up until the engine coolant temperature reaches 70°C (158°F) or higher.
Drive the vehicle at approximately 62 mph (100 km/h) for 20 seconds or more.
On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES and check if any DTCs (any pending DTCs) are set.
ES–106
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0101)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with the CAN
VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
ES
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0101 and other codes are output
A
Only P0101 is output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0101 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK VENTILATION HOSE
OK:
Ventilation hose is connected correctly and is not
damaged.
NG
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE VENTILATION HOSE
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0110
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
DTC
P0112
Intake Air Temperature Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0113
Intake Air Temperature Circuit High Input
ES–107
DESCRIPTION
Fig. 1
Resistance kΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A067628E03
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, built into the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter, monitors the intake air
temperature. The IAT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the intake air
temperature. When the intake air temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the
temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected as voltage changes to
the ECM terminal (see Fig. 1).
The IAT sensor is connected to the ECM. The 5 V power source voltage in the ECM is applied to the IAT
sensor from terminal THA via resistor R.
The resistor R and the IAT sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the IAT sensor
changes in accordance with changes in the intake air temperature, the voltage at terminal THA (THAR)
also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel injection volume to improve driveability
during cold engine operation.
DTC No.
P0110
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit for 0.5
seconds
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor circuit
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor (built into Mass Air Flow [MAF]
meter)
ECM
P0112
Short in IAT sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
Short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
ECM
P0113
Open in IAT sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
Open in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built into MAF meter)
ECM
ES–108
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
After confirming DTC "P0110, P0112 or P0113", use the intelligent tester to confirm the intake air
temperature in the "DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL".
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40°C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F)
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the intake air temperature. When
the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the IAT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the sensor voltage output is -40°C (-40°F) or more than 140°C (284°F).
ES
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0110: IAT sensor range check (fluttering)
P0112: IAT sensor range check (low resistance)
P0113: IAT sensor range check (high resistance)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
IAT sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
The typical enabling condition is not available
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0110:
IAT sensor voltage [Intake air temperature]
Less than 0.18 V, or more than 4.91 V (More than 140°C (284°F), or less than -40°C (40°F))
P0112:
IAT sensor voltage [Intake air temperature]
Less than 0.18 V (More than 140°C (284°F))
P0113:
IAT sensor voltage [Intake air temperature]
More than 4.91 V (Less than -40°C (-40°F))
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
0.18 V (140°C (284°F)) to 4.91 V (-40°C (-40°F))
ES–109
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
M1
Intake Air Temperature Sensor (Built in Mass Air Flow Meter)
ECM
5V
THA 4
Y-B
E2 5
BR
22
THA
E4
28
R
E2
E4
ES
A072925E26
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR.
(d) Read the values.
Standard:
Same value as actual Intake Air Temperature (IAT).
Result
Intake Air Temperature
Proceed to
-40°C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or more
B
OK (same as present temperature)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -40°C (-40°F).
• If there is a short circuit, the intelligent tester indicates
140°C (284°F) or more.
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–110
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
(a) Disconnect the M1 Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
connector.
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the MAF meter wire
harness side connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR.
(f) Read the value.
Standard:
140°C (284°F)
(g) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
ECM
MAF Meter Connector
THA
E2
ES
Wire Harness Side:
MAF Meter Connector
OK
M1
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW
METER
THA
E2
Front View
A137831E01
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN ECM)
MAF Meter Connector
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the E4 ECM
connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check
for the ECM connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR.
(f) Read the value.
Standard:
140°C (284°F)
(g) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
ECM
THA
E2
E4
NG
THA
E2
ECM Connector
A137832E01
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO ECM. IF
OK, REPLACE ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–111
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
MAF Meter Connector
ECM
THA
E2
A084869E61
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR.
(e) Read the value.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(f) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
NG
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN ECM)
MAF Meter Connector
ECM
THA
E2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR.
(f) Read the value.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reconnect the MAF meter connector.
NG
E4
ECM Connector
A137834E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–12
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
ES
HINT:
Inspect the vehicle's ECM using check mode. Intermittent
problems are easier to detect with the intelligent tester when
the ECM is in check mode. In check mode, the ECM uses 1
trip detection logic, which is more sensitive to malfunctions
than normal mode (default), which uses 2 trip detection logic.
1. Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35).
2. Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the intelligent tester (See page ES-36).
3. Perform a simulation test (See page IN-30).
4. Check and wiggle the harness(es), connector(s) and
terminal(s) (See page IN-38).
ES–13
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction is not confirmed by the DTC check,
troubleshooting should be carried out in all circuits
considered to be possible causes of the problem. In many
cases, by carrying out the basic engine check shown in the
following flowchart, the location of the problem can be found
quickly and efficiently. Therefore, using this check is essential
when engine troubleshooting.
1
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
NOTICE:
Perform this check with the engine stopped and ignition
switch OFF.
NG
Result
Proceed to
11 V or more
OK
Below 11 V
NG
CHARGE OR REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE WILL CRANK
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
OK
3
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE STARTS
NG
GO TO STEP 6
OK
4
CHECK AIR FILTER
(a) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
contaminated with dirt or oil.
NG
REPLACE AIR FILTER
OK
5
CHECK IDLING SPEED
(a) Check the idling speed (See page EM-2).
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
ES
ES–14
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
6
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-6).
NG
PROCEED TO TROUBLESHOOTING
OK
7
CHECK FOR SPARK
(a) Check for spark (See page IG-1).
ES
NG
OK
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PROCEED TO TROUBLESHOOTING
ES–112
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0111
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Gradient Too
High
DESCRIPTION
Fig. 1
Resistance
(kΩ)
Acceptable
ES
Temperature
(°C)
(°F)
A067628E24
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, mounted on the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter, monitors the IAT.
The IAT sensor has a built-in thermistor with a resistance that varies according to the temperature of the
intake air. When the IAT is low, the resistance of the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high,
the resistance drops. These variations in resistance are transmitted to the ECM as voltage changes (see
Fig. 1).
The IAT sensor is powered by a 5 V supply from the THA terminal of the ECM, via resistor R.
Resistor R and the IAT sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the IAT sensor
changes, the voltage at terminal THA also varies accordingly. Based on this signal, the ECM increases
the fuel injection volume when the engine is cold to improve driveability.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0111
When either condition below is met:
1. The intake air temperature rise is large, from the
previous trip warm-up to the following trip (2 trip
detection logic).
2. When the change in the intake air temperature after
engine start is less than the threshold value.
Trouble Area
Mass air flow meter assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs OBD II monitoring based on the values from the intake air temperature sensor. If there
is no change in the sensor value within the normal range, the ECM will not be able to perform OBD II
monitoring or will misdiagnose that there is a malfunction in the sensor. The ECM detects the stuck intake
air temperature sensor value by performing monitoring after the ignition switch is turned OFF or after the
engine is started (short soak or long soak).
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–113
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0111: Intake air temperature sensor rationality (After engine stop)
P0111: Intake air temperature sensor rationality (After cold engine
start)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Sub)
-
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
0.5 hours or more
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs are not present
None
After engine stop:
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
ECT sensor circuit
OK
ECT change since engine
Less than 180°C (356°F)
ECT before engine stop
70°C (158°F) or more
Time that MAF is low before engine stop
70 minutes
Accumulated MAF amount before engine stop
2,567 g or more
Key-off duration
30 minutes
After cold engine start:
Key-off duration
5 hours
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
ECT sensor circuit
OK
ECT
70°C (158°F) or more
Accumulated MAF amount
2,567 g or more
Either of the following conditions 1 or 2 is met:
-
1. Duration while engine load is low
10 seconds or more
2. Duration while engine load is high
10 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
After engine stop:
IAT change
Less than 1°C (2°F)
After cold engine start:
IAT change
Less than 1°C (2°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0110 (see page ES-104).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0111)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
ES
ES–114
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0111 and other DTCs
A
P0111
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0111 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
ES
B
A
GO TO DTC CHART
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–115
DTC
P0115
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit
DTC
P0117
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0118
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
A thermistor is built into the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor and changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as the Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
sensor.
HINT:
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, it operates the fail-safe function in which the ECT is
assumed to be 80°C (176°F).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0115
Open or short in Engine Coolant
Temperature (ECT) sensor circuit for
0.5 seconds
•
•
•
Open or short in Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor circuit
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
ECM
P0117
Short in ECT sensor circuit for 0.5
seconds
•
•
•
Short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
P0118
Open in ECT sensor circuit for 0.5
seconds
•
•
•
Open in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC "P0115, P0117 or P0118", use the intelligent tester to confirm the engine coolant
temperature in the "DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL".
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40°C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The
ECT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine
coolant. When the coolant temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the
temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output
from the sensor. The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the ECT. When
the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the ECT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the ECM calculates that the ECT is -40°C (-40°F) (P0118) or more than 140°C (284°F) (P0117) and
if either condition continues for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0115: ECT sensor range check (fluttering)
P0117: ECT sensor range check (low resistance)
P0118: ECT sensor range check (high resistance)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
ECT sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
ES
ES–116
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not
present
None
The typical enabling condition is not available
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0115:
ECT sensor voltage [Engine coolant temperature]
ES
Less than 0.14 V, or more than 4.91 V (More than 140°C (284°F), or less than -40°C
(40°F))
P0117:
ECT sensor voltage [Engine coolant temperature]
Less than 0.14 V (More than 140°C (284°F))
P0118:
ECT sensor voltage [Engine coolant temperature]
More than 4.91 V (Less than -40°C (-40°F))
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ECT sensor voltage [ECT]
0.14 V (140°C (284°F)) to 4.91 V (-40°C (-40°F))
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
E2
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
5V
2
R-L
21 THW
E4
1
BR
28
E4
R
E2
A115913E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–117
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP.
(d) Read the values.
Standard:
Same value as the actual ECT.
Result
Engine Coolant Temperature
Proceed to
-40°C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or more
B
OK (same as present temperature)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -40°C (-40°F).
• If there is a short circuit, the intelligent tester indicates
140°C (284°F) or more.
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
ECM
ECT Sensor
E2
THW
E2
Wire Harness Side
ECT Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the E2 Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT)
sensor connector.
(b) Connect terminals 1 and 2 of the ECT sensor wire
harness side connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP.
(f) Read the value.
Standard:
140°C (284°F) or more
(g) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
OK
E2
Front View
A103711E11
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE ENGINE
COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES
ES–118
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN ECM)
E2
ECT Sensor
ECM
THW
E2
ES
E4
(a) Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
(b) Connect terminals THW and E2 of the E4 ECM
connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check
for the ECM connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP.
(f) Read the value.
Standard:
140°C (284°F) or more
(g) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
NG
THW
E2
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION TO ECM. IF
OK, REPLACE ECM
ECM Connector
A112667E12
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
E2
ECT Sensor
ECM
THW
E2
A075766E19
(a) Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP.
(e) Read the value.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(f) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
OK
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5
ES–119
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN ECM)
ECT Sensor
E2
ECM
THW
E2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP.
(f) Read the value.
Standard:
-40°C (-40°F)
(g) Reconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
E4
ECM Connector
A112668E11
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
REPLACE ECM
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
ES–483
MASS AIR FLOW METER
VG
+B
E2G
Air
30
20
E2
THA
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT OUTPUT VOLTAGE
(a) Apply battery voltage across terminals 3 (+B) and 4
(E2G).
(b) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal 5
(VG), and the negative (-) tester probe to terminal 4
(E2G).
(c) Blow air into the MAF meter, and check if the
voltage fluctuates.
2.
INSPECT RESISTANCE
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between terminals 2 (THA) and 1 (E2).
Resistance:
12.5 to 16.9 kΩ at -20°C (-4°F)
2.19 to 2.67 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
0.50 to 0.68 kΩ at 60°C (140°F)
5 4 3 2 1
RESISTANCE kΩ
10
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
Acceptable
0.1
20 40 60 80 100
-20
0
(-4) (32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
TEMPERATURE °C (°F)
A076691E01
3.
Air
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a) If using a intelligent tester:
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Blow air into the MAF meter, and check that the
air flow value of the CURRENT DATA changes.
If operation is not as specified, check the MAF
meter as well as the wiring and the ECM.
A072564E01
ECM
VG
E2G
Voltmeter
A072565E02
(b) If not using a intelligent tester:
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) Connect the positive tester probe of the
voltmeter to terminal VG of the ECM and the
negative tester probe of the voltmeter to
terminal E2G of the ECM.
(3) Blow air into the air flow meter, and check if the
voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified, check the MAF
meter, the wiring and the ECM.
ES
ES–120
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0116
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range /
Performance Problem
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-110).
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0116
When either of following conditions met (2 trip detection
logic):
• When cold engine started and engine warmed up,
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor value does
not change.
• After warmed up engine stopped and then next cold
engine start performed, ECT sensor value does not
change.
Trouble Area
•
•
Thermostat
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ECT sensor cold start monitor
When a cold engine start is performed and then the engine is warmed up, if the ECT sensor value does
not change, it is determined that a malfunction has occurred. If this is detected in 2 consecutive driving
cycles, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
ECT sensor soak monitor
If the ECT sensor value does not change after the warmed up engine is stopped and then the next cold
engine start is performed, it is determined that a malfunction has occurred. If this is detected in 2
consecutive driving cycles, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0116: Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor stuck (low ECT)
P0116: ECT sensor stuck (high ECT)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Intake air temperature sensor, Crankshaft position sensor, Mass air flow meter
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
1 seconds or more
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF sensor)
Cold start monitor:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
1 second or more
ECT at engine start
Less than 60°C (140°F)
IAT sensor circuit
OK
Soak time
0 seconds or more
Accumulated MAF
2,157 g or more
Fuel cut
OFF
Difference between ECT at engine start and IAT
Less than 40°C (72°F)
Soak monitor:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
ES–121
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
IAT sensor circuit
OK
Soak time
5 hours or more
ECT at engine start
60°C (140°F) or more
Accumulated MAF
4,202 g or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Cold start monitor:
ECT sensor value change
Less than 5°C (9°F)
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor stuck (high Engine Coolant Temperature):
Difference between current ECT sensor value and previous
ECT sensor value when engine stopped
Less than 5°C (9°F)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Engine coolant temperature
ES
Varies with actual engine coolant temperature
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-111).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTC P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, the ECT sensor circuit may
be open or shorted. Perform the troubleshooting of DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118 first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0116)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0116
A
P0116 and other DTCs
B
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat (See page CO-9).
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat
(See page CO-9).
ES–122
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard opening temperature:
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
HINT:
In addition to the above check, confirm that the valve is
completely closed when the temperature is below the
standard.
(c) Reinstall the thermostat (See page CO-10).
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–123
DTC
P0120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit
DTC
P0122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P0220
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit
DTC
P0222
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0223
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2135
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A" /
"B" Voltage Correlation
HINT:
This is the purpose for the "throttle position sensor".
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
• This throttle position sensor is a non-contact type.
The Throttle Position (TP) sensor is mounted on the throttle body and it detects the opening angle of the
throttle valve. This sensor is electronically controlled and uses Hall-effect elements so that accurate
control and reliability can be obtained. The throttle position sensor has 2 sensor elements, VTA1 and
VTA2, each with their own signal outputs. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and VTA2 is
used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. Voltage applied to VTA1 and VTA2 changes between 0 V to 5 V in
proportion to the opening angle of the throttle valve. There are several checks that the ECM performs to
confirm proper operation of the throttle position sensor.
The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these signals input from terminals
VTA1 and VTA2, and the ECM controls the throttle actuator to set the throttle valve angle properly in
response to driver inputs.
ES
ES–124
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fail-safe Angle*
Throttle Position
Sensor Output Voltage
VTA2
VTA1
2.55 V
Throttle Position
Sensor
Magnet
ES
5.0 V
IC No. 1
2.25 V
0.93 V
0.69 V
ECM
7°
5V
VC
Usable Range
0°
84°
Throttle Valve Opening Angle
VTA1
Throttle Valve Fully Closed (Throttle position
expressed as percentage (VTA1) 10 to 20%)
VTA2
E2
IC No. 2
Throttle Valve Fully Opened (Throttle position
expressed as percentage (VTA1) 64 to 96%)
Magnet
*: Fail-safe Angle 7° (Throttle position expressed
as percentage (VTA1) about 10 to 16%)
A019802E48
DTC No.
-
P0120
P0122
P0123
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Condition (a) of DTC P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220,
P0222 or P0223 continues for 2 seconds (Open or short in
the throttle position sensor circuit)
-
Detection conditions for DTCs P0122 and P0123 are not
satisfied but condition (a) is satisfied:
(a) VTA1 is "0.2 V or less" or VTA1 is "4.435 V or more"
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
ECM
(a) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Short in VTA1 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
(a) VTA1 is 4.535 V or more
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Open in VTA1 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA1 circuit are short-circuited
ECM
ES–125
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0220
Detection conditions for DTCs P0222 and P0223 are not
satisfied but condition (a) is satisfied
(a) VTA2 is "1.75 V or less" or VTA2 is "4.8 V or more"
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
ECM
P0222
(a) VTA2 is 1.75 V or less
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Short in VTA2 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0223
(a) VTA2 is 4.8 V or more, and VTA1 is between 0.2 V and
2.02 V
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Open in VTA2 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA2 circuits are short-circuited
ECM
P2135
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 second or more, or
condition (b) continues for 0.4 second or more:
(a) Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is 0.02 V or less
(b) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less and VTA2 is 1.75 V or less
•
•
•
VTA1 and VTA2 circuits are short-circuited
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
ECM
NOTICE:
When a malfunction is detected, the throttle valve is locked at a certain opening angle. Also, the
whole electronically controlled throttle operation is cancelled until the system returns to normal
and the ignition switch is turned OFF.
HINT:
• After confirming DTCs, use the intelligent tester to confirm the throttle valve opening percentage and
closed throttle position switch condition.
• THROTTLE POS is the VTA1 signal. THROTTLE POS #2 is the VTA2 signal.
Reference (Normal condition):
Tester Display
Accelerator Pedal Fully Released
Accelerator Pedal Fully Depressed
THROTTLE POS
10 to 24%
64 to 96%
THROTTLE POS #2
2.1 to 3.1 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
(a)There is a specific voltage difference expected between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening
angle.
If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is incorrect, the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set a
DTC.
(b)VTA1 and VTA2 each have a specific voltage operating range.
If VTA1 or VTA2 is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set a
DTC.
(c) VTA1 and VTA2 should never be close to the same voltage levels.
If VTA1 is within 0.02 V of VTA2, the ECM interprets this as a short circuit in the throttle position sensor
system and will set a DTC.
FAIL-SAFE
If the ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel infection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue at a minimum speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
ES
ES–126
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0120: Throttle position sensor 1 range check (fluttering)
P0122: Throttle position sensor 1 range check (low voltage)
P0123: Throttle position sensor 1 range check (high voltage)
P0220: Throttle position sensor 2 range check (fluctuating)
P0222: Throttle position sensor 2 range check (low voltage)
P0223: Throttle position sensor 2 range check (high voltage)
P2135: Throttle position sensor range check (correlation)
Required sensors/components (Main)
Throttle position sensor
Required sensors/components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Accelerator pedal ON: 2 seconds
Accelerator pedal OFF: 10 seconds
P2135: 0.5 seconds or 0.4 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Throttle control motor power
ON
Ignition switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0120:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less, or 4.435 V or more
P0122:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
P0123:
VTA1 voltage
4.535 V or more
P0220:
VTA1 voltage
1.75 V or less or 4.8 V or more
P0222:
VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less
P0223:
VTA2 voltage when the VTA1 is 0.2 to 2.02 V
4.8 V or more
P2135:
Either of the following condition A or B is met
-
Condition A
-
Difference between VTA and VTA2 voltage
0.02 V or less
Condition B
-
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VTA1 voltage
0.6 to 3.96 V
VTA2 voltage
2.25 to 5.0 V
ES–127
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T2 Throttle Position Sensor (Built in Throttle w/ Motor Body)
VC
VTA1
VTA2
E2
5
R
ECM
23
VC
E4
L-R
6
20
E4
Y
19
VTA2
E4
R-B
4
3
W
VTA1
BR
ES
28
E4 E2
G038679E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (THROTTLE POS, THROTTLE POS #2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS / THROTTLE POS and
THROTTLE POS #2 .
(d) Read the value.
Depressed
Released
FI07052E06
Result
Throttle position expressed as percentage and voltage
Accelerator pedal depressed
THROTTLE POS
(VTA1)
THROTTLE POS #2
(VTA2)
Accelerator pedal released
THROTTLE POS
(VTA1)
THROTTLE POS #2
(VTA2)
Trouble Area
Proceed to
ES–128
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
0%
0 to 0.2 V
0%
0 to 0.2 V
VC circuit open
100 %
4.5 to 5.5 V
100 %
4.5 to 5.5 V
E2 circuit open
0 % or 100 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
(fail-safe)
0 % or 100 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
(fail-safe)
VTA1 circuit open or
ground short
10 to 24 %
(fail-safe)
0 to 0.2 or 4.5 to 5.5
V
10 to 24 %
(Fail safe)
0 to 0.2 or 4.5 to 5.5
V
VTA2 circuit open or
ground short
10 to 24 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
64 to 96 %
(Does not fail safe)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(Does not fail safe)
TP sensor circuit is
normal
B
A
B
Go to step 5
A
ES
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side
Throttle Body Assembly Connector
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle body connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
VTA2
Tester Connection
VTA1
T2
VTA1 (T2-6) - VTA1 (E4-20)
E2
Front View
VC
Specified Condition
VC (T2-5) - VC (E4-23)
VTA2 (T2-4) - VTA2 (E4-19)
Below 1 Ω
E2 (T2-3) - E2 (E4-28)
VC (T2-5) or VC (E4-23) - Body
ground
ECM Connector
E4
VTA1 (T2-6) or VTA1 (E4-20) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VTA2 (T2-4) or VTA2 (E4-19) - Body
ground
VTA2
VC
E2
VTA1
OK
(d) Reconnect the throttle body connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
A115698E02
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–129
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
Wire Harness Side
Throttle Body Assembly Connector
T2
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle body connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage of the ECM.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VC (E4-23) - E2 (E4-28)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the throttle body connector.
VC
Front View
E2
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES
ECM Connector
E4
VC
E2
A115699E03
OK
4
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
(a) Replace the throttle body (See page ES-495).
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE
OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Clear the DTC (See page ES-35).
(d) Start the engine and allow the engine to idle for 15
seconds or more.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(f) Read the DTC.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 or P2135
A
No output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
ES–130
A
REPLACE ECM
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0121
ES–131
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit Range / Performance Problem
HINT:
This is the purpose of the throttle position sensor.
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 (See page ES-118).
DTC No.
P0121
DTC Detection Condition
Difference between voltage output of VTA1 and VTA2
deviates from the threshold for 2.0 seconds.
Trouble Area
Throttle Position (TP) sensor (built into throttle body)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
This sensor includes 2 signals: VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and
VTA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. There are several checks that the ECM performs to confirm
proper operation of the throttle position sensor and VTA1.
There is a specific voltage difference expected between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening angle.
If the voltage output difference of the VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction of the throttle position sensor. The ECM will illuminate the MIL and set a
DTC. This monitor runs for 2 seconds (the first 2 seconds of engine idle) after the engine is started (1 trip
detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0121: Throttle Position (TP) sensor rationality
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
TP sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 2 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
None
Either of following conditions is set
Condition A or B
A. Ignition switch
ON
B. Electric throttle motor power
ON
TP sensor malfunction (P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220,
P0222, P0223, P2135)
Not detected
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of following conditions is met
-
Difference of TP sensor voltage between VTA1 and (VTA2 x
0.8)
Higher than 1.6 V
Difference of TP sensor voltage between VTA1 and (VTA2 x
0.8)
Lower than 0.8 V
ES
ES–132
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE
If the ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel infection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue at a minimum speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0120 (See page ES-122).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
• This is the repair procedure of the throttle position sensor.
1
READ OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0121)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0121
A
P0121 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0121 are output, perform
the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
A
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
ES–133
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Insufficient Coolant Temperature for Closed
Loop Fuel Control
P0125
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-110).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Engine coolant temperature hardly changes for 77
seconds after engine start
(2 trip detection logic)
P0125
Engine coolant temperature hardly changes for 129
seconds after engine start
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Thermostat
Engine coolant temperature hardly changes for 1200
seconds after engine start
(2 trip detection logic)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the temperature of the engine coolant.
The resistance of the sensor varies with the actual coolant temperature. The ECM applies a voltage to the
sensor and the varying resistance of the sensor causes the signal voltage to vary. The ECM monitors the
ECT signal voltage after engine start-up. If the sensor still reports that the engine is not warmed up
enough for closed-loop fuel control after sufficient time has passed, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the sensor or cooling system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECT is 0°C (32°F) at engine start. After 77 seconds running time, the ECT sensor still indicates that
the engine is not warm enough to begin air-fuel ratio feedback control of the air-fuel ratio. The ECM
interprets this as a fault in the sensor or cooling system and will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0125: Insufficient engine coolant temperature for closed-loop fuel control
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Thermostat, Cooling system
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine coolant temperature sensor, Mass air flow meter
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
77 seconds: -8.34°C (16.98°F) or more
129 seconds: -19.45 to -8.34°C (-3.01 to 16.98°F)
1200 seconds: Less than -19.45°C (-3.01°F)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
Case 1
Engine coolant or intake air temperature at engine start
-8.34°C (16.98°F) or higher
Case 2
Engine coolant or intake air temperature at engine start
Between -19.45°C (-3.01°F) and -8.34°C (16.98°F)
Case 3
Engine coolant or intake air temperature at engine start
Lower than -19.45°C (-3.01°F)
ES
ES–134
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Engine coolant temperature sensor output
Less than 0°C (32°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0115 (See page ES-111).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
• If DTCs P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, an ECT sensor circuit
may be open or shorted. Perform the troubleshooting of DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118 first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0125)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0125
A
P0125 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0125 is output, perform the
troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat (See page CO-9).
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat
(See page CO-9).
OK:
Valve opening temperature is 80 to 84°C (176 to
183°F)
HINT:
Also check that the valve is completely closed below the
opening temperature shown above.
(c) Reinstall the thermostat (See page CO-10).
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–135
OK
3
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
(a) Check that there is a defect in the cooling system which
causes overcool, such as abnormal radiator fan
operation, modified cooling system and so on.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES
ES–136
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0128
Thermostat Malfunction
HINT:
This is the purpose of the thermostat malfunction detection.
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) does not reach 75°C (167°F) despite
sufficient engine warm-up time.
DTC No.
P0128
ES
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) Cold start
(b) After sufficient warm-up time has elapsed
(c) ECT is less than 75°C (167°F)
•
•
•
•
Thermostat
Cooling system
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 seconds
Estimated ECT
Threshold
(75°C (167°F))
Indicated ECT Reading
ECT
Time
DTC Set (after 2 Driving Cycles)
A121605E02
The ECM estimates the coolant temperature based on starting temperature, engine loads, and engine
speeds. The ECM then compares the estimated temperature with the actual ECT. When the estimated
coolant temperature reaches 75°C (167°F), the ECM checks the actual ECT. If the actual ECT is less than
75°C (167°F), the ECM will interpret this as a fault in the engine cooling system or thermostat and set a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0128: Coolant thermostat
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Thermostat, Engine cooling system
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–137
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine coolant temperature sensor, Intake air temperature sensor,
Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per drive cycle
Duration
15 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0010, P0020 (OCV Bank 1, 2)
P0011 (VVT System 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT System 1 - Retard)
P0021 (VVT System 2 - Advance)
P0022 (VVT System 2 - Retard)
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0308 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340 - P0346 (VVT sensor 1, 2)
P0351 - P0358 (igniter)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor - rationality)
P2237, P2240 (A/F sensor - open)
P2A00, P2A03 (A/F sensor - slow response)
Battery voltage
11 V or higher
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met
Conditions (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
-15 to 7°C (-27 to 12.6°F)
(b) ECT at engine start
-10 to 56°C (14 to 133°F)
(c) IAT at engine start
-10 to 56°C (14 to 133°F)
2. All of the following conditions are met
Conditions (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
More than 7°C (12.6°F)
(b) ECT at engine start
56°C (133°F) or less
(c) IAT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or more
Accumulated time that vehicle speed is 80 mph (128 km/h) or
more
Less than 20 sec.
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Duration that all of following conditions are met
5 seconds or more
(a) Estimated ECT
75°C (167°F) or higher
(b) ECT sensor output
Lower than 75°C (167°F)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
ES
ES–138
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0128)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED II
/ DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTC.
ES
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0128
A
P0128 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0128 are output, perform
the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
(a) Check for defects in the cooling system that might cause
the system to be too cold, such as an abnormal radiator
fan operation or a modified cooling system.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK:
Valve opening temperature is 80 to 84°C (176 to
183°F)
HINT:
Also check that the valve is completely closed below the
opening temperature shown above.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat (See page CO-9).
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat
(See page CO-9).
Standard:
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–139
HINT:
In addition to the above check, confirm that the valve is
completely closed when the temperature is below the
standard.
(c) Reinstall the thermostat (See page CO-10).
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–140
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0136
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0137
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0138
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0156
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0157
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0158
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 2
Sensor 2)
ES
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted behind the Three-Way Catalyst Converter (TWC) and located far
from the engine assembly.
In order to obtain a high purification rate of the carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and nitrogen
oxide (NOx) components in the exhaust gas, a TWC is used. For the most efficient use of the TWC, the air
fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air fuel level. For the
purpose of helping the ECM to deliver accurate air fuel ratio control, a Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor is
used.
The HO2 sensor is located behind the TWC, and detects the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas.
Since the sensor is integrated with the heater that heats the sensing portion, it is possible to detect the
oxygen concentration even when the intake air volume is low (the exhaust gas temperature is low).
When the air fuel ratio becomes lean, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas is rich. The HO2
sensor informs the ECM that the post-TWC air fuel ratio is lean (low voltage, i.e. less than 0.45 V).
Conversely, when the air fuel ratio is richer than the stoichiometric air fuel level, the oxygen concentration
in the exhaust gas becomes lean. The HO2 sensor has the property of changing its output voltage
drastically when the air fuel ratio is close to the stoichiometric level.
The ECM uses the supplementary information from the HO2 sensor to determine whether the air fuel ratio
after the TWC is rich or lean, and adjusts the fuel injection time accordingly. Thus, if the HO2 sensor is
working improperly due to internal malfunctions, the ECM is unable to compensate for deviations in the
primary air fuel ratio control.
ES–141
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Atmosphere Air
Ideal Air Fuel Mixture
Housing
Output Voltage
Platinum Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Heater
ES
Coating (Ceramic)
Cover
Richer - Air Fuel Ratio - Leaner
Exhaust Gas
A115539E02
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0136
P0156
During active air fuel ratio control, following conditions (a)
and (b) are met for certain period of time (2 trip detection
logic):
(a) Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor voltage does not
decrease to less than 0.2 V
(b) HO2 sensor voltage does not increase to more than
0.6 V
P0136
P0156
Sensor impedance less than 5 Ω for more than 30
seconds when ECM presumes sensor to being warmed up
and operating normally (1 trip detection logic)
P0137
P0157
During active air fuel ratio control, following conditions (a)
and (b) are met for certain period of time (2 trip detection
logic):
(a) HO2 sensor voltage output less than 0.21 V
(b) Target air fuel ratio rich
P0137
P0157
High impedance:
Sensor impedance 348.1 MΩ or more for more than 90
seconds when ECM presumes sensor to being warmed up
and operating normally (1 trip detection logic)
P0138
P0158
During active air fuel ratio control, following conditions (a)
and (b) are met for certain period of time (2 trip detection
logic):
(a) HO2 sensor voltage output 0.59 V or more
(b) Target air fuel ratio lean
P0138
P0158
HO2 sensor voltage output exceeds 1.2 V for more than
30 seconds (1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
(bank 1, 2 sensor 2) circuit
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor heater (bank 1, 2
sensor 2)
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
EFI relay
Gas leakage from exhaust system
•
•
•
•
•
Open in HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2) circuit
HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
HO2 sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
EFI relay
Gas leakage from exhaust system
•
•
•
•
Short in HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2) circuit
HO2 sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
ECM internal circuit malfunction
Air-Fuel ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2)
•
•
ES–142
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
1. Active Air Fuel ratio Control
The ECM usually performs air fuel ratio feedback control so that the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor output
indicates a near stoichiometric air fuel level. This vehicle includes active air fuel ratio control in addition
to regular air fuel ratio control. The ECM performs active air fuel ratio control to detect any deterioration
in the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor malfunctions (refer to
the diagram below).
Active air fuel ratio control is performed for approximately 15 to 20 seconds while driving with a warm
engine.
During active air fuel ratio control, the air fuel ratio is forcibly regulated to become lean or rich by the
ECM.
If the ECM detects a malfunction, one of the following DTCs is set: DTC P0136, P0156 (abnormal
voltage output), P0137, P0157 (open circuit) and P0138, P0158 (short circuit).
2. Abnormal Voltage Output of HO2 Sensor (DTC P0136 and P0156)
While the ECM is performing active air fuel ratio control, the air fuel ratio is forcibly regulated to
become rich or lean. If the sensor is not functioning properly, the voltage output variation is small. For
example, when the HO2 sensor voltage does nor decrease to less than 0.21 V and does not increase
to more than 0.59 V during active air fuel ratio control, the ECM determines that the sensor voltage
output is abnormal and sets DTC P0136.
HO2 SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION (P0136 and P0156: ABNORMAL VOLTAGE)
15 to 20 seconds
Operation
Active air fuel
ratio control
Off
Normal
0.59 V
HO2 sensor
voltage
Abnormal
0.21 V
A115540E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–143
3. Open or short in the Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor Circuit (DTC P0137, P0157, P0138 or P0158)
During active air fuel ratio control, the ECM calculates the Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC)* of the
Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) by forcibly regulating the air fuel ratio to become rich or lean.
If the HO2 sensor has an open or short, or the voltage output of the sensor noticeably decreases, the
OSC indicates an extraordinarily high value. Even if the ECM attempts to continue regulating the air
fuel ratio to become rich or lean, the HO2 sensor output does not change.
While performing active air fuel ratio control, when the target air fuel ratio is rich and the HO2 sensor
voltage output is 0.21 V or less (lean), the ECM interprets this as an abnormally low sensor output
voltage and sets DTC P0137 or P0157. When the target air fuel ratio is lean and the voltage output is
0.59 V or more (rich) during active air fuel ratio control, the ECM determines that the sensor voltage
output is abnormally high, and sets DTC P0138 or P0158.
HINT:
DTC P0138 or P0158 is also set if the HO2 sensor voltage output is more than 1.2 V for 30 seconds or
more.
*: The TWC has the capability to store oxygen. The OSC and the emission purification capacity of the
TWC are mutually related. The ECM determines whether the catalyst has deteriorated, based on the
calculated OSC value (See page ES-230).
ES
ES–144
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HO2 SENSOR CIRCUIT LOW VOLTAGE (P0137 and P0157: OPEN)
15 to 20 seconds
Operation
Active air fuel
ratio control
Target air fuel ratio
Off
Abnormal
Normal
Stoichiometric
Air Fuel Level
Normal
Rich
ES
HO2 sensor
voltage
0.21 V
Abnormal
HO2 SENSOR CIRCUIT HIGH VOLTAGE (P0138 and P0158: SHORT)
Operation
Active air fuel
ratio control
Target air fuel ratio
HO2 sensor
voltage
Off
Lean
Stoichiometric
Air Fuel Level
Abnormal
0.59 V
A115541E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–145
4. High or Low Impedance of Heated Oxygen (HO2) Sensor (DTC P0136, P0156, P0137 or P0157)
Interrelation between temperature of
the element and impedance:
DTC Detection Area
Impedance Ω
15,000
1,000
100
10
5
300
(572)
400
(752)
500
600
700
800
(932) (1,112) (1,292) (1,472)
Temperature °C (°F)
A131134E01
During normal air fuel ratio feedback control, there are small variations in the exhaust gas oxygen
concentration. In order to continuously monitor the slight variation of the HO2 sensor signal while the
engine is running, the impedance* of the sensor is measured by the ECM. The ECM determines that
there is a malfunction in the sensor when the measured impedance deviates from the standard range.
HINT:
• *: The effective resistance in an alternating current electrical circuit.
• The impedance cannot be measured using an ohmmeter.
• DTC P0136 or P0156 indicates the deterioration of the HO2 sensor. The ECM sets the DTC by
calculating the impedance of the sensor when the typical enabling conditions are satisfied (1 driving
cycle).
• DTC P0137 or P0157 indicates an open circuit in the HO2 sensor (1 driving cycle). The ECM sets
this DTC when the impedance of the sensor exceeds the threshold 348.1 MΩ.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0136: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1) output voltage (Output
voltage)
P0136: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1) impedance (Low)
P0137: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1) output voltage (Low voltage)
P0137: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1) impedance (High)
P0138: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1) output voltage (High voltage)
P0138: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1) output voltage (Extremely
high)
P0156: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2) output voltage (Output
voltage)
P0156: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2) impedance (Low)
P0157: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2) output voltage (Low voltage)
P0157: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2) impedance (High)
P0158: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2) output voltage (High voltage)
P0158: Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2) output voltage (Extremely
high)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Heated oxygen sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Mass air flow meter
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle: Active air-fuel ratio control detection
Continuous: Others
ES
ES–146
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Duration
20 seconds: Heated oxygen sensor output (Output voltage, High
voltage, Low voltage)
30 seconds: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low)
90 seconds: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High)
10 seconds: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Extremely high)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
ES
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 (O2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0308 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0455, P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor - rationality)
P2237, P2240 (A/F sensor - open)
P2440 (AIR control valve stuck open)
P2441 (AIR control valve stuck close)
P2444 (AIP stuck ON)
P2445 (AIP stuck OFF)
P2A00, P2A03 (A/F sensor - slow response)
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage, High voltage, Low voltage):
Active air-fuel ratio control
Executing
Active air-fuel ratio control being when all of following conditions are
met:
-
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine coolant temperature
75°C (167°F) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine RPM
Less than 3,200 rpm
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed loop
Fuel-cut
OFF
Engine load
10 to 70 %
Shift position
4th or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low):
Battery voltage
11 V or higher
Estimated sensor temperature
Lower than 700°C (1,292°F)
ECM monitor
Completed
P0606
Not set
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Estimated sensor temperature
450 to 750°C (842 to 1,382°F)
P0606
Not set
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Extremely high):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Time after engine start
2 seconds or more
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–147
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage):
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a), (b) and (c)
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or less
(b) Rear HO2S voltage
0.21 to 0.59 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
3 g or more
2. All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a), (b) and (c)
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.9 or more
(b) Rear HO2S voltage
0.21 to 0.59 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
3 g or more
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Low voltage):
All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2 and 3
1. Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or less
2. Rear HO2S voltage
Less than 0.21 V
3. OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
3 g or more
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (High voltage):
All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2 and 3
1. Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.9 or more
2. Rear HO2S voltage
More than 0.59 V
3. OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
3 g or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low):
Duration of the following condition
30 seconds or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance
Less than 5 Ω
Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High):
Duration of the following condition
90 seconds or more
Heated oxygen sensor impedance
348.1 MΩ or more
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Extremely high):
Duration of the following condition
10 seconds or more
Heated oxygen sensor voltage
More than 1.2 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Heated Oxygen sensor voltage
Varies between 0.1 and 0.9 V
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0037 (See page ES-88).
ES
ES–148
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
Between
[H]
40 and 70 mph (64
and 113 km/h )
Idling
ES
[G]
Ignition Switch ON
Warm up
10 minutes
Time
(Note: Even when vehicle stops during pattern, test can be resumed.)
A115372E39
A116412
NOTICE:
This test will not be completed if the vehicle is driven under absolutely constant speed, such as
with cruise control activated.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM [A].
2. Turn the ignition switch ON [B].
3. Turn the tester ON [C].
4. Clear DTCs (if set) (See page ES-35) [D].
5. Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / CARB OBD II / READINESS TESTS [E].
6. Check that O2S EVAL is INCMPL (incomplete) [F].
7. Start the engine and warm it up [G].
8. Drive the vehicle at between 40 mph and 70 mph (64 km/h and 113 km/h) for at least 10 minutes [H].
9. Note the state of the Readiness Tests items. Those items will change to COMPL (complete) as O2S
EVAL monitor operates [I].
ES–149
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
10.Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES and
check if any pending DTCs are set [J].
HINT:
If O2S EVAL does not change to COMPL, and any pending DTCs fail to set, extend the driving time.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection
volume by 25 %.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.5
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
1
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
ES
ES–150
Case
2
3
ES
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.5 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2. Then press
the YES button and ENTER button, followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
• If other DTCs relating to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
• If the OX1B wire from the ECM connector is short-circuited to the +B wire, DTC P0136 will be set.
• If the OX2B wire from the ECM connector is short-circuited to the +B wire, DTC P0156 will be set.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0138 or P0158
A
P0137 or P0157
B
P0136 or P0156
C
B
Go to step 13
ES–151
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
C
Go to step 6
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) After warming up the engine, run the engine at 2,500
rpm for 3 minutes.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2.
(d) Allow the engine to idle.
(e) Read the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor output voltage
while idling.
Result
HO2 Sensor Output Voltage
Proceed to
More than 1.2 V
A
Less than 1.0 V
B
B
Go to step 5
A
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 5 minutes.
(b) Disconnect the E4 and E5 ECM connectors.
(c) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance
E4
E5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT1B (E4-1) - OX1B (E4-18)
10 kΩ or higher
HT2B (E5-5) - OX2B (E5-33)
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
HT2B
OK
HT1B
OX2B
OX1B
ECM Connector
A116424E04
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–152
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the HO2 sensor connector.
Standard resistance (Bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
Component Side
HO2 Sensor
+B
HT
H6
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
H8
NG
ES
E1
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OX
A137828E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
5
CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
HINT:
This A/F sensor test is to check the A/F sensor current during
the fuel-cut. When the sensor is normal, the sensor current
will indicate below 3 mA in this test.
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Drive the vehicle by the drive pattern as listed below:
(1) Warm up the engine.
(2) Drive the vehicle at 60 km/h (40 mph) or more for 10
minutes or more.
(3) Stop the vehicle.
(4) Accelerator the vehicle until 60 km/h (40 mph) or
more and decelerate for 3 seconds or more.
Perform this three times.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–153
Drive Pattern:
40 mph
(60 km/h)
0 mph
(0 km/h)
10 minutes or more
ES
3 seconds or more 3 seconds or more 3 seconds or more
A152792E01
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / MONITOR INFO / MONITOR RESULT.
(d) Confirm that RANGE B1S1 is either PASS or FAIL.
(e) Select RANGE B1S1 an press ENTER.
(f) Read the test value.
Standard:
Less than 3.0 mA
NOTICE:
Do not turn the engine switch Off during this step
because the test results will be lost.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Start the engine.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / O2S B1S2.
(e) After warming up the engine, run the engine at an engine
speed of 2,500 rpm for 3 minutes.
(f) Read the output voltage of the HO2 sensor when the
engine rpm is suddenly increased.
ES–154
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 3 times using
the accelerator pedal.
Standard voltage:
Fluctuates between 0.4 V or less and 0.5 V or more.
NG
Go to step 13
OK
7
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
ES
8
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0136, P0156)
(a) On the intelligent tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
(b) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 or P0156
A
No output
B
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
9
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Replace the HO2 sensor (See page EX-2).
NEXT
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
11
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0136 or P0156)
(a) On the intelligent tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
(b) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 or P0156
A
No output
B
ES–155
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
REPAIR COMPLETE
A
12
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INJECTION VOLUME)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
Warn up the engine.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / INJ VOL.
(e) Change the injection volume using the tester, monitoring
the voltage output of Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) and HO2
sensors displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• Change the fuel injection volume within the range of 12 % and +12 %. The injection volume can be
changed in 1 % graduations within the range.
• The A/F sensor is displayed as AFS B1S1 (AFS
B2S1), and the HO2 sensor is displayed as O2S
B1S2 (O2S B2S2) on the intelligent tester.
Result
Tester Display (Sensor)
Voltage Variations
Proceed to
AFS B1S1 (AFS B2S1) (A/F)
Alternates between more than 3.3 V and
less than 3.3 V
OK
AFS B1S1 (AFS B2S1) (A/F)
Remains at more than 3.3 V
NG
AFS B1S1 (AFS B2S1) (A/F)
Remains at less than 3.3 V
NG
HINT:
A normal HO2 sensor voltage (O2S B1S2 or O2S B2 S2)
reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in
fuel injection volumes. When the A/F sensor voltage
remains at either less than 3.3 V or more than 3.3 V
despite the HO2 sensor indicating a normal reaction, the
A/F sensor is malfunctioning.
ES
ES–156
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Injection Volume
+12 %
Malfunction
-12 %
A/F Sensor
Output
Normal
3.3 V
HO2 Sensor Output
ES
Malfunction
1V
0V
A121606E01
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR EXTREMELY RICH OR LEAN ACTUAL AIR FUEL RATIO AND REPAIR
CAUSE (FUEL INJECTOR, FUEL PRESSURE, EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE, ETC.)
13
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAK
(a) Check for exhaust gas leakage from the exhaust
manifold and pipe.
OK:
No exhaust gas leakage.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST GAS
LEAKAGE POINT
ES–157
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
14
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the H6 or H8 HO2 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the HO2 sensor connector.
Standard resistance (Bank 1, 2 sensor 2)
Component Side
HO2 Sensor
+B
HT
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - E1 (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the HO2 sensor connector.
H6
NG
H8
E1
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
ES
OX
A137828E02
OK
15
INSPECT EFI RELAY
(a) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E02
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the EFI relay.
NG
OK
Tester Connection
REPLACE EFI RELAY
ES–158
16
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR)
Wire Harness Side
Heated Oxygen Sensor Connector
Bank 1 Sensor 2, Bank 2 Sensor 2
H6
HT
(a) Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 and E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
+B
H8
OX
E1
ES
ECM Connector
E4
E5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OX (H6-3) - OX1B (E4-18)
Below 1 Ω
HT (H6-1) - HT1B (E4-1)
Below 1 Ω
OX (H8-3) - OX2B (E5-33)
Below 1 Ω
HT (H8-1) - HT2B (E5-5)
Below 1 Ω
OX (H6-3) or OX1B (E4-18) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (H6-1) or HT1B (E4-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
OX (H8-3) or OX2B (E5-33) Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT (H8-1) or HT2B (E5-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT2B
HT1B
OX1B
OX2B
A121612E05
Reference (System Diagram of Bank 1 Sensor 2)
ECM
Heated Oxygen Sensor
EFI
EFI Fuse
EFI No. 2 Fuse
Heater
HT1B
From
Battery
Sensor
OX1B
Duty
Control
E2
MREL
Ground
A137814E04
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–159
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
ES
ES–160
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0171
System Too Lean (Bank 1)
DTC
P0172
System Too Rich (Bank 1)
DTC
P0174
System Too Lean (Bank 2)
DTC
P0175
System Too Rich (Bank 2)
DESCRIPTION
ES
The fuel trim is related to the feedback compensation value, not to the basic injection time. The fuel trim
consists of both the short-term and the long-term fuel trims.
The short-term fuel trim is fuel compensation that is used to constantly maintain the air fuel ratio at
stoichiometric levels. The signal from the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor indicates whether the air fuel ratio is
rich or lean compared to the stoichiometric ratio. This triggers a reduction in the fuel injection volume if the
air fuel ratio is rich and an increase in the fuel injection volume if it is lean.
Factors such as individual engine differences, wear over time and changes in operating environment
cause short-term fuel trim to vary from the central value. The long-term fuel trim, which controls overall
fuel compensation, compensates for long-term deviations in the fuel trim from the central value caused by
the short-term fuel trim compensation.
If both the short-term and long-term fuel trims are lean or rich beyond predetermined values, it is
interpreted as a malfunction, and the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
DTC No.
P0171
P0174
DTC Detection Condition
When air fuel ratio feedback is stable after warming up
engine, fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side (2
trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0172
P0175
When air fuel ratio feedback is stable after warming up
engine, fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side (2
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air induction system
Injector blockage
Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2
sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
EFI relay
PCV piping
ECM
Injector leak or blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2
sensor 1) circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
HINT:
• When DTC P0171 or P0174 is recorded, the actual air fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC
P0172 or P0175 is recorded, the actual air fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
• If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0171 or P0174 may be recorded. The
MIL is then illuminated.
• If the total of the short-term fuel trim value and long-term fuel trim value is within the malfunction
threshold (and ECT is more than 75°C (167°F)), the system is functioning normally.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–161
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Under closed-loop fuel control, fuel injection amounts that deviate from the ECM's estimated fuel amount
will cause a change in the long-term fuel trim compensation value. Long-term fuel trim value is adjusted
when persistent deviations in the short-term fuel trim's value are present. Also, the smoothed fuel trim
learning value is adjusted when deviations from the ECM's simulated fuel injection value are present. The
smoothed fuel trim learning value is the combination of smoothed short-term fuel trim (fuel feedback
compensation value) and smoothed long-term fuel trim (learning value of the air fuel ratio). When the
smoothed fuel trim learning value exceeds the malfunction threshold, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the fuel system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The average fuel trim learning value is more than +35 % or less than -35 %, the ECM interprets this as a
fuel system malfunction.
ES
Fuel Compensation
Amount
P0171, P0174
+35%:
Malfunction Threshold
of LEAN Condition
1.35
1.0
P0172, P0175
-35%:
Malfunction Threshold
of RICH Condition
0.65
A121607E01
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0171: Fuel trim Lean (bank 1)
P0172: Fuel trim Rich (bank 1)
P0174: Fuel trim Lean (bank 2)
P0175: Fuel trim Rich (bank 2)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Oxygen sensor, A/F sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine coolant temperature sensor, Mass Air Flow meter, Crankshaft
position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
ES–162
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
ES
P0010, P0020 (OCV Bank 1, 2)
P0011 (VVT System 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT System 1 - Retard)
P0021 (VVT System 2 - Advance)
P0022 (VVT System 2 - Retard)
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0351 - P0358 (Igniter)
P0500 (VSS)
P2440 (AIR control valve stuck open)
P2441 (AIR control valve stuck close)
P2444 (AIP stuck ON)
P2445 (AIP stuck OFF)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Fuel system status
Closed loop
Either of following conditions is met
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) Engine RPM
Less than 1,000 rpm
(b) Intake air amount per revolution
0.26 g/rev. or more
Catalyst monitor
Not executed
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Fuel trim:
EVAP purge-cut
Executing
Either of following conditions is met
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) Average between short-term fuel trim and long-term fuel trim
+35 % or more (varies with ECT)
(b) Average between short-term fuel trim and long-term fuel trim
-35 % or less (varies with ECT)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-368).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection
volume by 25 %.
ES–163
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
1
2
3
4
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2. Then press
the YES button and ENTER button, followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES
ES–164
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a rich air fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run rich.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a lean air fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run lean.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
ES
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175
A
P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0171, P0172, P0174 and P0175
are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF VENTILATION HOSE
OK:
Ventilation hose is connected correctly and is not
damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VENTILATION HOSE
OK
3
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leaks.
OK :
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
4
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/F CONTROL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
ES–165
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for
approximately 90 seconds.
(d) On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(e) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in
an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT button to
change the fuel injection volume.)
(f) Monitor the outputs of A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1
and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2) displayed
on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection
volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume
by 25 %.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases in
the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
Result
Status
AFS B1S1
or
AFS B2S1
Status
O2S B1S2
or
O2S B2S2
A/F Condition and
A/F Sensor
Condition
Misfires
Lean/Rich
Lean/Rich
Normal
-
Suspected Trouble
Area
Proceed to
-
C
•
•
•
•
Lean
Lean
Actual air fuel ratio
lean
May occur
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rich
Rich
Actual air fuel ratio
lean
•
•
•
•
Ventilation valve
and hose
Ventilation hose
connections
Injector
blockage
Gas leakage
from exhaust
system
Air induction
system
Fuel pressure
Mass Air Flow
(MAF) meter
Engine Coolant
Temperature
(ECT) sensor
A
Injector leakage
or blockage
Gas leakage
from exhaust
system
Injection system
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
A
ES
ES–166
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Status
AFS B1S1
or
AFS B2S1
Status
O2S B1S2
or
O2S B2S2
A/F Condition and
A/F Sensor
Condition
Misfires
Lean
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor
malfunction
-
•
A/F sensor
B
Rich
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor
malfunction
-
•
A/F sensor
B
Suspected Trouble
Area
Proceed to
Lean: During A/F CONTROL, the A/F sensor output
voltage (AFS) is consistently more than 3.35 V, and the
HO2 sensor output voltage (O2S) is consistently less
than 0.4 V.
Rich: During A/F CONTROL, the AFS is consistently less
than 3.0 V, and the O2S is consistently more than 0.55 V.
Lean/Rich: During A/F CONTROL of the ACTIVE TEST,
the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor
alternates correctly.
ES
B
Go to step 11
C
Go to step 15
A
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COOLANT TEMP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
(d) Read the COOLANT TEMP value when the engine is
cold and warmed-up.
Standard:
ECT when the engine is cold: Same as ambient
temperature
ECT when the engine is warmed-up: 75 to 95°C
(167 to 203°F)
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MAF)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF and COOLANT
TEMP.
(d) Allow the engine to idle until the COOLANT TEMP
reaches 75°C (167°F) or more.
(e) Read the MAF with the engine in an idling condition and
at an engine speed of 2, 500 rpm.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–167
Standard:
MAF at idle rpm: 1.4 g/sec. and 2.3 g/sec. (shift
lever is in N position and A/C is OFF)
MAF at 2,500 rpm: 5.4 g/sec. and 7.9 g/sec. (shift
lever is in N position and A/C is OFF)
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
7
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-6).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
8
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAK
OK:
No gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST SYSTEM
OK
9
CHECK FOR SPARK AND IGNITION
(a) Check for spark and ignition (See page IG-1).
HINT:
If the spark plugs or ignition system malfunction, engine
misfire may occur. The misfire counter can be read with the
intelligent tester. Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / CYL #1 (to
CYL #8).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE IGNITION SYSTEM
OK
10
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR (INJECTION AND VOLUME)
(a) Inspect the fuel injector (See page FU-11).
HINT:
If the injectors are malfunctioning, engine misfire may occur.
The misfire counter can be read with the intelligent tester.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD
II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / CYL #1 (to CYL #8).
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR
ES
ES–168
11
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor
A12
A13
HT
+B
AF-
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
Front View
A085152E60
ES
Tester Connection
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
12
INSPECT A/F RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F relay from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E02
OK
NG
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
REPLACE A/F RELAY
ES–169
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
13
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A12
HT
+B
AF-
ECM Connector
E5
HA1A
HA2A
A2A+
A1A+
A2A-
A1A-
Specified Condition
+B (2) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
(e) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(f) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
A13
AF+
Tester Connection
Tester connection
Specified Condition
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A121613E02
Tester connection
Specified Condition
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body
ground
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body
ground
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body
ground
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
ES
ES–170
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
A/F HEATER
A/F Sensor
ECM
A/F Heater Fuse
From
Battery
Heater
+B
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
Sensor
AF-
A1A-
ES
Duty
Control
From EFI Relay
A118002E16
NG
OK
14
NEXT
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
15
ES–171
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
Between
[F]
38 and 75 mph
(60 and 120 km/h)
Idling
ES
[E]
Ignition Switch OFF
[A], [B], [C], [D]
Warming up
3 to 5 minutes
Time
A115372E40
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM
[A].
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON [B].
(c) Clear DTCs (See page ES-35) [C].
(d) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the tester (See page ES-36) [D].
(e) Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories
switched OFF [E].
(f) Drive the vehicle at between 38 and 75 mph (60 and 120
km/h) and at an engine speed of between 1,400 rpm and
3,200 rpm for 3 to 5 minutes [F].
HINT:
If the system is still malfunctioning, the MIL will be
illuminated during step [F].
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed,
no malfunction will be detected.
NEXT
16
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 OR P0175)
(a) On the intelligent tester, enter the following menu:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
CURRENT CODES.
(b) Read DTCs.
ES–172
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175
B
B
A
END
ES
Go to step 5
ES–173
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0230
Fuel Pump Primary Circuit
DESCRIPTION
In the diagram below, when the engine is cranked, current flows from terminal STAR NSW of the ECM to
the starter relay coil and also current flows to terminal STA of the ECM (STA signal).
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, the Tr1 (power transistor 1) is turned ON,
current flows to the coil of the circuit opening relay, the relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel
pump, and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated (engine running), the ECM keeps the Tr1 ON (circuit opening relay ON)
and the fuel pump also keeps operating.
The fuel pump speed is controlled at two levels (high speed or low speed) by the engine condition
(starting, light load, heavy load). When the engine starts (STA ON), the Tr2 (power transistor 2) in the
ECM is OFF, so the fuel pump relay closes and battery positive voltage is applied directly to the fuel
pump. The fuel pump operates at high speed.
After the engine starts during idling or light loads, since the Tr2 goes ON, power is supplied to the fuel
pump via the fuel pump resistor. The fuel pump operates at low speed.
EFI
ECM
EFI Relay
Fuel Pump Resistor
MREL
C/OPN Relay
Fuel Pump Relay
Ignition Switch
FPR
Tr2
STA
FC
Tr1
IGN
Fuel Pump
AM2
STA Relay
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
N
P
Battery
Starter
Crankshaft Position Sensor
(NE Signal)
STAR
NE+
A078887E02
ES
ES–174
DTC No.
P0230
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in fuel pump relay circuit
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in fuel pump relay circuit
Fuel pump relay
ECM
Circuit opening relay
Fuel pump
ES–175
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C/OPN Relay
B-O
2
C
J4
J/C
2
C
B-O
1
2
5
3
GR-B
2
GR-B
10
E8 FC
35
IC4
W-G
8
E8 MREL
2
B-W
Engine Room R/B
B
Driver
Side J/B
23 1E
33
IC4
W-G
IGN
B-W
Engine Room R/B
6 1D
2
2
3
2
EFI
Relay
B-R
5
FUEL
PUMP
Relay
5
2
1
2
B-R
2
B-Y
1
J/C
L
2
G-R
5
G-R
IC4
F8
Fuel Pump
Resistor
W-B
B J2
7
2
4
2
IG2
2
I18
Ignition SW
6
3
1
2
19
30
G-R
IM2
E6 FPR
AM2
B J3
R
2
2
2
1
B-R
B-R
2
AM2
2
2 IB1
EFI
1
W-B
4 B-R
F14
Fuel Pump
5 W-B
2
Engine Room R/B
A J41
B
Battery
EB
A
J41
A J40
W-B
BO
W-B
BL
A131137E02
HINT:
This troubleshooting procedure is based on the premise that the engine is started. If the engine is not
started, proceed to the problem symptoms table (See page ES-26).
ES
ES–176
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ECM (FPR VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
E6
ES
FPR
(a) Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
FPR (E6-30) - E1 (E6-1)
STA signal ON
9 to 14 V
FPR (E6-30) - E1 (E6-1)
STA signal OFF
0 to 3 V
NG
E1
REPLACE ECM
E118245E07
OK
2
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuel pump relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 - 2, 3 - 4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
A030519E02
(c) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RELAY
ES–177
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL PUMP RELAY - ECM)
ECM Connector
E6
FPR
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine Room R/B (Fuel pump relay
terminal 1) - FPR (E6-30)
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room R/B (Fuel pump relay
terminal 1) or FPR (E6-30) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
Engine Room R/B:
NG
Fuel Pump Relay
A137919E01
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–15
REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) must be input
into the replacement ECM.
HINT:
The VIN is a 17-digit alphanumeric vehicle identification
number. The intelligent tester is required to register the VIN.
1.
2.
DESCRIPTION
This registration section consists of three parts, Input
Instructions, Read VIN and Write VIN.
(a) Input Instructions: Explains the general VIN input
instructions using an intelligent tester.
(b) Read VIN: Explains the VIN reading process in a
flowchart. This process allows the VIN stored in the
ECM to be read, in order to confirm that the two
VINs, provided with the vehicle and stored in the
vehicle's ECM, are the same.
(c) Write VIN: Explains the VIN writing process in a
flowchart. This process allows the VIN to be input
into the ECM. If the ECM is changed, or the VIN and
VIN do not match, the VIN can be registered, or
overwritten in the ECM by following this procedure.
INPUT INSTRUCTIONS
HINT:
Below are the general VIN input instructions using the
intelligent tester.
(a) General
The arrow buttons (UP, DOWN, RIGHT and LEFT)
and numerical buttons (0 to 9) are used to input the
VIN.
(b) Cursor Operation
To move the cursor around the tester screen, press
the RIGHT and LEFT buttons.
(c) Alphabetical Character Input
(1) Press the UP and DOWN buttons to select the
desired alphabetical character.
(2) After selection, the cursor should move.
(d) Numeric Character Input
(1) Press the numerical button corresponding to
the number that you want to input.
(2) After input, the cursor should move.
HINT:
Numerical characters can be selected by using
the UP and DOWN buttons.
(e) Correction
(1) When correcting the input character(s), put the
cursor onto the character using the RIGHT or
LEFT button.
(2) Select or input the correct character using the
UP/DOWN buttons, or the numerical buttons.
(f) Finishing Input Operation
(1) Make sure that the input VIN matches the
vehicle VIN after input.
ES
ES–16
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(2) Press the ENTER button on the tester.
3.
READ VIN (Vehicle Identification Number)
HINT:
Below are the VIN reading instructions. Use the
procedures and flowchart below. Reading the VIN stored
in the ECM is necessary when comparing it to the VIN
provided with the vehicle.
(a) Read VIN using the intelligent tester.
(b) Check the vehicle's VIN.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn the tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / VIN.
ES
Menu Screen:
Select VIN READ
DTC P0630 Set
VIN Previously Stored
VIN Not Stored
17-digit VIN
displayed
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
A103812E03
ES–17
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
WRITE VIN
HINT:
Below are the VIN writing instructions. Use the
procedures and flowchart below. This process allows the
VIN to be input into the ECM. If the ECM is changed, or
the ECM VIN and Vehicle VIN do not match, the VIN can
be registered or overwritten in the ECM by following this
procedure.
(a) Write VIN using the intelligent tester.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Turn the tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / VIN.
ES
Menu Screen:
Select VIN WRITE
VIN Previously Stored
[NO]
[YES]
[YES]
[YES]
To Menu
Screen
17-digit VIN displayed
[NO]
Continue to next illustration
To Menu Screen
A103813E01
ES–18
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
New Registration
Input Instructions
[ENTER]
ES
[ENTER]
[ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input Error
[EXIT]
Continue to next illustration
A103814E07
ES–19
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Writing Successful
Writing Error
Communication Error
ES
[ENTER]
To Menu Screen
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
A103815E03
ES–178
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0300
Random / Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected
DTC
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0305
Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0306
Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0307
Cylinder 7 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0308
Cylinder 8 Misfire Detected
DESCRIPTION
When a misfire occurs in the engine, hydrocarbons (HC) enter the exhaust in high concentrations. If the
HC concentration is too high, exhaust emissions levels may increase. High concentrations of HC can also
cause the temperature of the catalyst to increase, possibly damaging the catalyst. To prevent the increase
in emissions and limit the possibility of thermal damage, the ECM monitors the misfire rate. When the
temperature of the catalyst reaches a point of thermal degradation, the ECM will begin flashing the MIL.
For monitoring misfires, the ECM uses both the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor and the Crankshaft
Position (CKP) sensor. The CMP sensor is used to identify misfiring cylinders and the CKP sensor is used
to measure variations in the crankshaft rotation speed. The misfire counter records how many times the
crankshaft rotation speed variations exceed threshold values.
If the misfiring rate exceeds the threshold value and could cause emissions to deteriorate, the ECM
illuminates the MIL.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0300
Misfiring of random cylinder is detected
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in engine wire harness
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connections
Ignition system
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
Compression pressure
Valve timing
Valve clearance
Ventilation valve and hose
Ventilation hose connections
ECM
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
P0307
P0308
Misfiring of each cylinder is detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
ES–179
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
In some cases, several DTCs for misfired cylinders (DTCs P0301 to P0308) are recorded but the random/
multiple cylinder misfire DTC (P0300) is not recorded. This is an indication that the misfires were detected
and recorded at different times. Random misfire codes are recorded only when several misfires occur at
the same time.
Reference: Inspect using an oscilloscope.
With the engine idling, check the waveform between terminals #10 to #80 and E1 of the ECM connectors.
The correct waveform is as shown.
Injector Signal Waveform
Magnification
10 V/DIV.
10 V/DIV.
ES
GND
GND
100 msec./DIV. (Idling)
Injection Duration
1 msec./DIV. (Idling)
A121608E02
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Camshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
ECM
(36-2 teeth or 12 teeth)
A121609E03
The ECM illuminates the MIL (2 trip detection logic) if:
When the percentage of misfire exceeds the specified limit per 1,000 engine revolutions. One occurrence
of excessive misfire during engine start will set the MIL. Four occurrences are required to set the MIL
1,000 revolutions after engine start.
The ECM begins blinking the MIL as follows (2 trip detection logic is used and DTC is stored after 2 trip
detection):
• Within 200 crankshaft revolutions at a high rpm, the threshold for "percent of misfires causing catalyst
damage" is reached once.
• Within 200 crankshaft revolutions at a normal rpm, the threshold for "percent of misfires causing
catalyst damage" is reached 3 times.
ES–180
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0300: Multiple cylinder misfire
P0301: Cylinder 1 misfire
P0302: Cylinder 2 misfire
P0303: Cylinder 3 misfire
P0304: Cylinder 4 misfire
P0305: Cylinder 5 misfire
P0306: Cylinder 6 misfire
P0307: Cylinder 7 misfire
P0308: Cylinder 8 misfire
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Camshaft position sensor, Crankshaft position sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine coolant temperature sensor, Intake air temperature sensor,
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Every 1,000 revolutions (soon after engine is started: 1 time, other: 4
times) (emission related misfire)
Every 200 revolutions (1 or 3 times) (catalyst deteriorating misfire)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles: MIL ON
Blinking immediately: Catalyst-damaged-misfire
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0327 - P0333 (knock sensor)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
VVT system
Not operate by scan tool
Engine RPM
400 to 5,700 rpm
Fuel cut
OFF
When both conditions below are met
Conditions 1 and 2
1. ECT
-10°C (14°F) or more
2. Either of following conditions is met
Conditions (a) or (b)
(a) Engine start ECT
Higher than -7°C (19°F)
(b) ECT
Higher than 20°C (68°F)
Monitor period of emission-related misfire:
First 1,000 revolutions after engine start, or Check Mode
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions
Except above
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions x 4
Monitor period of emission-related misfire:
All of following conditions 1, 2 and 3 are met
Crankshaft 200 revolutions
Except above
Crankshaft 200 revolutions x 3
1. Driving cycles
1st
2. Check Mode
OFF
3. RPM
Less than 2,800 revolutions
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Emission-related-misfire:
Misfire rate
1.2 % or more
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–181
Catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
Number of misfire per 200 revolutions
93 or more (varies with intake air amount and RPM)
Multiple cylinders misfire
Detected
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0351 (See page ES-208).
ES
ES–182
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
I9
Injector No. 1
B-R
B-R
R-L
1
B-R
4 EB1
ES
R-L
2
A
I11
Injector No. 3
B-R
B-R
B-R
B-R
B-R
IG2
I18
Ignition SW
4
#30
E6
G
6
#50
E6
W
3
#70
E4
L
3
#20
E6
Y
5
#40
E6
R
7
#60
E6
BR
2
#80
E4
W-B
7
E01
E4
1
2
I10
Injector No. 2
B-R
B-R
1
2
I12
Injector No. 4
B-R
AM2
7
B-R
1
2
I14
Injector No. 6
R
B-R
B-R
2
Engine
Room R/B
2
1
2
I16
Injector No. 8
AM2
B-R
1
1
2
2
#10
E6
W
1
2
I15
Injector No. 7
8 EA1
6
A
1
2
I13
Injector No. 5
B-R
B-R
ECM
J26
J/C
2
B
W-B
6
E02
E4
Battery
EE
A131141E01
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Record the DTC and freeze frame data.
3. Set check mode on the intelligent tester (See page ES-36).
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–183
4. Read the value on the misfire counter for each cylinder when idling. If the value is displayed on the
misfire counter, skip the following procedure of confirmation driving.
5. Drive the vehicle several times while using the DATA LIST's MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD menu
items to keep track of the vehicle's engine speed, load and its surrounding range.
If you have no intelligent tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is simulated once. Then
repeat the simulation process.
HINT:
In order to force output of the DTC, it is necessary to drive with MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD
selected in the DATA LIST for the period of time in the chart below. Do not turn the ignition switch OFF.
Turning the ignition switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to normal mode and
all DTCs, freeze frame data and other data are erased.
Engine RPM
Time
Idling
3.5 minutes or more
1,000 rpm
3 minutes or more
2,000 rpm
1.5 minutes or more
3,000 rpm
1 minute or more
6. Check if a misfire occurs by monitoring DTC output and the freeze frame data. Then, record the DTCs,
freeze frame data and misfire counter data.
7. Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for at least 5 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs other than misfire DTCs are output simultaneously, troubleshoot the non-misfire DTCs first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine conditions
when malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air fuel ratio was lean or rich,
and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• If the misfire does not occur when the vehicle is brought to the workshop, the misfire can be confirmed
by reproducing the conditions recorded in the freeze frame data. Also, after finishing repairs, confirm
that no misfire occurs (see confirmation driving pattern).
• On 6 and 8 cylinder engines, cylinder-specific misfire fault codes are disabled at high engine speeds.
If the misfire starts in a high engine speed range or the misfire occurs only in a high engine speed area,
only general fault code P0300 will be stored.
When only P0300 is stored:
(a)Erase the general misfire fault code from the intelligent tester.
(b)Start the engine and drive the confirmation pattern (see confirmation driving pattern).
(c) Read the value of the misfire ratio for each cylinder. Or, check if a DTC was output.
(d)Perform repairs on the cylinder that has a high misfire ratio. Or repair the cylinder indicated by any
output DTCs.
(e)After finishing repairs, drive the confirmation pattern again and confirm that no misfire occurs.
• If either SHORT FT #1, LONG FT #1, SHORT FT #2 or LONG FT #2 in the freeze frame data is +-20
%, there is a possibility that the air fuel ratio is becoming RICH (-20 % or less) or LEAN (+20 % or
more).
• When COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 75°C (167°F), a misfire is only possible
during engine warm-up.
• If the misfire cannot be reproduced, the cause may be: 1) low fuel in the vehicle, 2) improper fuel in the
vehicle, 3) a contaminated ignition plug, or 4) another problem.
• Be sure to check the value on the misfire counter after repairs.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO MISFIRE DTCS)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
ES
ES–184
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the CURRENT CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 or
P0308
A
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 or
P0308 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 and P0308 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
ES
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MISFIRE RPM AND MISFIRE LOAD)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / MISFIRE / MISFIRE RPM and
MISFIRE LOAD.
(d) Read and note the MISFIRE RPM and the MISFIRE
LOAD (engine load) with the DATA LIST.
HINT:
The MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE LOAD displays have
vehicle data that can help lead to successful repairs of
any misfiring cylinders.
NEXT
3
CHECK CONNECTION OF VENTILATION HOSE
OK:
Ventilation hose is connected correctly and is not
damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VENTILATION HOSE
OK
4
CHECK MISFIRE COUNT (CYL #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #7, #8)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Clear the DTCs.
ES–185
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / CYL#1 to CYL#8.
(e) Allow the engine to idle.
(f) Read the misfire count of the cylinders #1 to #8.
If no misfire is counted for all of the cylinders, move the
shift lever into the D position and repeat the 2 previous
steps.
If misfires are still not counted, perform the next 2 steps.
(g) Drive the vehicle with MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE
LOAD selected in the DATA LIST.
(h) Read the misfire count of cylinders #1 to #8, or check for
any output DTCs.
Result
Misfire count in each cylinder
Proceed to
1 or 2 cylinders have some misfire counts
A
3 cylinders or more have some misfire counts
B
B
Go to step 14
A
5
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FUEL CUT #1 TO #8)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Allow the engine to idle.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL CUT #1 (to #8).
(e) If a cylinder has a high misfire count, cut fuel to the
cylinder. Compare the misfire count of the cylinder
before fuel cut and after fuel cut.
Result
Misfire count in each cylinder
Proceed to
Misfire count of the cylinder before fuel cut and after fuel cut are
roughly the same
A
Misfire count of the cylinder before fuel cut is lower than after
fuel cut
B
HINT:
If the misfire count of the cylinder before fuel cut and
after fuel cut are roughly the same, the cylinder is
misfiring.
If the misfire count of the cylinder before fuel cut is lower
than after fuel cut, the cylinder misfires sometimes.
NOTICE:
This ACTIVE TEST cannot be performed while the
vehicle is being driven.
B
A
Go to step 12
ES
ES–186
6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT SPARK PLUG
(a) Remove the engine cover.
(b) Remove the ignition coil and the spark plug of misfire
cylinder.
(c) Measure the spark plug electrode gap.
Standard:
The electrode gap is 1.0 to 1.3 mm (0.039 to 0.051
in.)
(d) Check the electrode for carbon deposits.
Recommended spark plug
Electrode Gap
A088861E04
ES
Manufacturer
Spark Plug Type
DENSO
SK20R11
NGK
IFR6A11
NOTICE:
If the electrode gap is larger than the standard,
replace the spark plug. Do not adjust the electrode
gap.
NG
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
OK
7
CHECK SPARK AND IGNITION
(a) Disconnect the fuel injector connectors to prevent the
engine from starting.
(b) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil.
(c) Attach the spark plug to the cylinder head cover.
(d) Crank the engine for 2 seconds or less and check if a
spark occurs.
OK:
Spark occurs
A088862E01
NG
Go to step 9
OK
8
CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE ON MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Measure the cylinder compression pressure of the
misfiring cylinder.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
CHECK ENGINE TO DETERMINE CAUSE OF LOW COMPRESSION
ES–187
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
9
CHANGE NORMAL SPARK PLUG AND CHECK SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) For inspection purposes, remove the current spark plug
and install a normally functioning spark plug.
(b) Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Always disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if a spark occurs while the engine is being
cranked.
OK:
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
OK
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
NG
REPLACE IGNITION COIL (THEN CONFIRM THAT THERE IS NO MISFIRE)
10
CHECK ECM (#10, #20, #30, #40, #50, #60, #70, #80 VOLTAGE)
#30 (+)
#20 (+)
#40 (+)
E4
E01 (-)
#10 (+)
E6
#80 (+)
#70 (+)
#50 (+)
#60 (+)
A116425E07
NG
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
#10 (E6-2) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#20 (E6-3) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#30 (E6-4) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#40 (E6-5) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#50 (E6-6) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#60 (E6-7) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#70 (E4-3) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
#80 (E4-2) - E01 (E4-7)
9 to 14 V
CHECK FUEL INJECTOR OF MISFIRING
CYLINDER
ES
ES–188
11
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL INJECTOR - ECM)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the ignition
coil and ECM (IGF terminal).
(1) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 or I8 ignition
coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Ignition Coil Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
ES
E4
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGF (I1-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I2-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I3-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I4-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I5-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I6-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I7-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Below 1 Ω
IGF (I8-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
IGF2
IGF1
A137920E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGF (I1-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I2-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I3-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I4-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I5-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I6-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I7-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF (I8-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the ignition coil connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–189
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Check the harness and connector between the ignition
coil and ECM (IGT terminals).
(1) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 or I8 ignition
coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Ignition Coil Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
E4
ECM Connector
IGT2
IGT1
IGT7
IGT5
IGT8
IGT4
IGT3
IGT6
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGT (I1-3) - IGT1 (E4-8)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I2-3) - IGT2 (E4-15)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I3-3) - IGT3 (E4-11)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I4-3) - IGT4 (E4-10)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I5-3) - IGT5 (E4-13)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I6-3) - IGT6 (E4-12)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I7-3) - IGT7 (E4-14)
Below 1 Ω
IGT (I8-3) - IGT8 (E4-9)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A137920E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGT (I1-3) or IGT1 (E4-8) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I2-3) or IGT2 (E4-15) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I3-3) or IGT3 (E4-11) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I4-3) or IGT4 (E4-10) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I5-3) or IGT5 (E4-13) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I6-3) or IGT6 (E4-12) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I7-3) or IGT7 (E4-14) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I8-3) or IGT8 (E4-9) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the ignition coil connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
12
CHECK FUEL INJECTOR OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
Check the injector injection (whether fuel volume is high or
low, and whether injection pattern is poor).
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR
OK
13
CHECK VALVE CLEARANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
NG
OK
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
ES
ES–190
14
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
15
CHECK VALVE TIMING
ES
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the engine cover.
Remove the drive belt.
Remove the timing belt cover LH and RH.
Turn the crankshaft to align the matchmarks of the
crankshaft.
(e) Align the notch of the crankshaft pulley with the "0"
position.
(f) Confirm whether the matchmarks of the camshaft pulley
and cylinder head cover are facing each other.
(g) If the matchmarks are not facing each other, turn the
crankshaft clockwise by 360°. Confirm again if the
matchmarks are facing each other.
OK:
The matchmarks of the camshaft pulley and the
cylinder head cover face each other when the
notch of the crankshaft pulley is in the "0" position.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
OK
16
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-6).
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE FUEL PUMP, FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR, FUEL PIPE LINE
AND FILTER
OK
17
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COOLANT TEMP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–191
(d) Read the COOLANT TEMP value when the engine is
cold and warmed-up.
Standard:
ECT when the engine is cold: Same as ambient
temperature
ECT when the engine is warmed-up: 75 to 95°C
(167 to 203°F)
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
18
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MAF)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF and COOLANT
TEMP.
(d) Allow the engine to idle until the COOLANT TEMP
reaches 75°C (167°F) or more.
(e) Read the MAF with the engine in an idling condition and
at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm.
Standard:
MAF at idle rpm: 4.0 to 8.0 g/sec. (shift lever is in N
position and A/C is OFF)
MAF at 2,500 rpm: 10.0 to 20.0 g/sec. (shift lever is
in N position and A/C is OFF)
NG
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
ES
ES–192
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0327
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
DTC
P0328
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
DTC
P0332
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit Low Input (Bank 2)
DTC
P0333
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit High Input (Bank 2)
DESCRIPTION
ES
A flat type knock sensor (non-resonant type) has a structure that can detect vibrations between
approximately 6 kHz and 15 kHz.
Knock sensors are fitted onto the engine block to detect engine knocking.
The knock sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes deformed.
The voltage is generated when the engine block vibrates due to knocking. Any occurrence of engine
knocking can be suppressed by delaying the ignition timing.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0327
P0332
Output voltage of knock sensor 1 or 2 is less than 0.5 V
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Short in knock sensor 1 or 2 circuit
Knock sensor 1 or 2
ECM
P0328
P0333
Output voltage of knock sensor 1 or 2 is more than 4.5 V
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open in knock sensor 1 or 2 circuit
Knock sensor 1 or 2
ECM
Reference: Inspect using an oscilloscope
The correct waveform is as shown.
KNK1 Signal Waveform
1V/ DIV.
GND
1 msec./ DIV.
A116426E01
Item
Content
Terminals
KNK1 - EKNK
or
KNK2 -EKN2
Equipment Settings
0.01 to 10 V/DIV.
0.01 to 10 msec./DIV.
Conditions
Keep engine speed at 4,000 rpm with
warm engine
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–193
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The knock sensor, located on the cylinder block, detects spark knock. When spark knock occurs, the
piezoelectric element of the sensor vibrates. When the ECM detects a voltage in this frequency range, it
retards the ignition timing to suppress the spark knock.
The ECM also senses background engine noise with the knock sensor and uses this noise to check for
faults in the sensor. If the knock sensor signal level is too low for more than 10 seconds, or if the knock
sensor output voltage is outside the normal range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the knock sensor
and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0327: Knock sensor (Bank 1) open/short (Low voltage)
P0328: Knock sensor (Bank 1) open/short (High voltage)
P0332: Knock sensor (Bank 2) open/short (Low voltage)
P0333: Knock sensor (Bank 2) open/short (High voltage)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Knock sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, Camshaft position sensor, Engine coolant
temperature sensor, Mass air flow meter
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
None
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
5 seconds or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Knock Sensor Range Check (Low voltage) P0327 and P0332:
Knock sensor voltage
Less than 0.5 V
Knock Sensor Range Check (High voltage) P0328 and P0333:
Knock sensor voltage
More than 4.5 V
ES
ES–194
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
K2
Knock Sensor (Bank 2)
ES
2
(*1)
B
1
W
K1
Knock Sensor (Bank 1)
(*1)
B
8
EB1
2
EB1
(*1)
2
R
7
EB1
1
G
6
EB1
(*1)
3
EB1
BR
W
(*1)
BR
20
E5 EKN2
21
E5 KNK2
R
28
E5 EKNK
G
29
E5 KNK1
(*1)
W-B
E
J28
J/C
E
W-B
ED
*1: Shielded
A130712E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• DTCs P0327 and P0328 are for the bank 1 knock sensor circuit.
• DTCs P0332 and P0333 are for the bank 2 knock sensor circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–195
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (CHECK KNOCK SENSOR CIRCUIT)
ECM
EB1
Knock Sensor
(a) Disconnect the EB1 connector.
(b) Using lead wires, connect the EB1 connectors as
follows.
Male Connector - Female Connector
2
2
1
1
6
6
7
7
2
2
8
8
29
E5
28
E5
21
E5
20
E5
Terminal 6 - Terminal 2
Terminal 2 - Terminal 6
Terminal 7 - Terminal 8
Terminal 8 - Terminal 7
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Warm up the engine.
Race the engine at 3,000 rpm for 10 seconds or more.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(g) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II/ DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(h) Read DTCs.
EB1
Female Connector
Male Connector
A115701E02
Result
Display
Proceed to
DTC is same as when vehicle brought in (for example, P0327 and
P0328 are output again, or P0332 and P0333 are output again)
A
DTC is different from when vehicle brought in (for example,
P0327 and P0328 are output at first, but then P0332 and P0333 are
output, or vice versa)
B
(i)
B
A
Reconnect the EB1 connector.
Go to step 5
ES
ES–196
2
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CONNECTOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the EB1 connector.
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
Male Connector
EB1
4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5
Front View
ES
E5
ECM Connector
KNK2
EKN2
EKNK
KNK1
A152654E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
EB1 male connector 6 - KNK1 (E5-29)
Below 1 Ω
EB1 male connector 7 - EKNK (E5-28)
Below 1 Ω
EB1 male connector 2 - KNK2 (E5-21)
Below 1 Ω
EB1 male connector 8 - EKN2 (E5-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
EB1 male connector 6 or KNK1 (E5-29) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
EB1 male connector 7 or EKNK (E5-28) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
EB1 male connector 2 or KNK2 (E5-21) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
EB1 male connector 8 or EKN2 (E5-20) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the EB1 connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT ECM
KNK2
(a) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between the specified ECM
terminals.
Standard voltage
EKN2
Tester Connection
KNK1
E5
4.5 to 5.5 V
KNK2 (E5-21) - EKN2 (E5-20)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
KNK1 (E5-29) - EKNK (E5-28)
EKNK
A131127E01
Specified Condition
REPLACE ECM
ES–197
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NOTICE:
The fault may be intermittent. Check the harness and
connectors carefully, and reset.
NEXT
END
5
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
Wire Harness Side
Female Connector
(a) Disconnect the EB1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EB1 female connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
EB1
EB1 female connector 6 - 7
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
EB1 female connector 2 - 8
Specified Condition
120 to 280 kΩ
(c) Reconnect the EB1 connector.
Front View
A152655E01
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CONNECTOR - KNOCK SENSOR)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the EB1
connector and the knock sensors.
NG
OK
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–484
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
Intelligent Tester
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
ES
A094482E03
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Start and warm up the engine.
(d) Connect the intelligent tester and select VVT from
the ACTIVE TEST menu.
(e) Check the engine speed when the OCV is operated
by the intelligent tester.
Idle speed:
650 to 750 rpm
OK
Condition
Specified Condition
VVT system is OFF (OCV is OFF)
Normal engine speed
VVT system is ON (OCV is ON)
Rough idle or engine stalled
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
ES–485
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (+B) - 2 (GND)
6.9 to 7.9 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
camshaft timing oil control valve.
Spool Valve
A097066E16
(b) Check the operation.
(1) Apply battery voltage across the terminals, and
check that the spool valve operates.
NOTICE:
Check that the spool valve is not stuck.
HINT:
The spool valve may not return if foreign
objects are caught in it. This may cause subtle
pressure leaks to the advance side, and a DTC
may be set.
ES
ES–198
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit
DTC
P0339
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Intermittent
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor system consists of a CKP sensor plate and a pickup coil.
The sensor plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft. The pickup coil is made of windings, an
iron core and magnet. The sensor plate rotates and as each tooth passes through the pickup coil, a pulse
signal is created. The pickup coil generates 32 signals for each engine revolution. Based on these
signals, the ECM calculates the crankshaft position and engine RPM. Using these calculations, the fuel
injection time and ignition timing are controlled.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
P0335
P0339
•
No CKP position sensor signal to ECM during
cranking (1 trip detection logic)
No CKP sensor signal to ECM with engine at 450 rpm
or more (1 trip detection logic)
No CKP sensor signal to ECM is input for 0.05 seconds or
more, and conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) 1,000 rpm or more
(b) Starter is OFF
(c) 3 seconds or more have elapsed after STA signal is
switched from ON or OFF
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Open or short in Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor
circuit
Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor
Signal plate (CKP sensor plate)
ECM
•
•
•
•
Open or short in CKP sensor circuit
CKP sensor
Signal plate (CKP sensor plate)
ECM
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
2 V/DIV
VV1
Ground
VV2
Ground
NE
Ground
20 msec./DIV (idling)
A131145E01
Reference: Inspect using an oscilloscope.
The correct waveform is as shown.
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VV1+ (E6-25) - VV1- (E6-24)
VV2+ (E6-18) - VV2- (E6-28)
G2+ (E6-19) - G2- (E6-29)
Correct waveform is as shown
NE+ (E6-21) - NE- (E6-20)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor even though the engine is revolving, the
ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the sensor.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–199
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Crankshaft position sensor range check or rationality
Required Sensors/Components
Crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
Required Sensors/Components
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Case 1: 3 times
Case 2: 0.016 second
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
ES
Case 1:
Time after starter OFF to ON
0.3 seconds or more
Number of camshaft position sensor signal pulse
6 times
Battery voltage
7 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
CMP sensor circuit fail
Not detected
Case 2:
Starter
OFF
Engine RPM
450 rpm or more
Time after starter from ON to OFF
3 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1:
Number of CKP sensor signal pulse
132 or less, or 174 or more
Case 2:
Engine speed signal
No signal for 0.016 second
ES–200
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
B
19
G2+
E6
W
29
G2E6
2
Camshaft Timing
Pulley LH
1
3
ES
C4
Crankshaft Position Sensor
L-R
E4 VC
W-B
E
E
J28
J/C
W-B
L
21
NE+
E6
Y
20
NEE6
1
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Plate No. 1
2
(Shielded)
ED
A152658E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If no problem is found by this diagnostic troubleshooting procedure, troubleshoot the engine
mechanical system.
• Check the engine speed. The engine speed can be checked by using the intelligent tester. To check,
follow the operation below:
(a)Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b)Start the engine.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d)Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / ENGINE SPD.
• The engine speed may be indicated as zero despite the engine revolving normally. This is caused by a
lack of NE signals from the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor. Alternatively, the engine speed may be
indicated as lower than the actual engine speed if the CKP sensor output voltage is insufficient.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–201
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the C4 Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
1-2
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
C4
A115704E02
HINT:
In the above section, the terms "cold" and "hot" refer to
the temperature of the coils.
"Cold" means approximately -10 to 50°C (14 to 122°F).
"Hot" means approximately 50 to 100°C (122 to 212°F).
(c) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the C4 crankshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
Crankshaft Position Sensor
C4
Tester Connection
Crankshaft position sensor (C4-1) NE+ (E6-21)
Crankshaft position sensor (C4-2) NE- (E6-20)
ECM Connector
E6
Crankshaft position sensor (C4-1) or
NE+ (E6-21) - Body ground
Crankshaft position sensor (C4-2) or
NE- (E6-20) - Body ground
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the CKP sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
NE+
NEA137922E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–202
3
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Check the sensor installation.
OK:
Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
OK
SECURELY REINSTALL SENSOR
NG
BR03795E15
ES
OK
4
CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE (TOOTH OF PLATE)
(a) Remove the crankshaft position sensor plate (See page
EM-18).
(b) Check the tooth of the signal plate.
OK:
Sensor plate does not have any cracks or
deformation.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR PLATE
ES–203
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P0341
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Range /
Performance (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
DTC
P0345
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit (Bank 2)
DTC
P0346
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Range /
Performance (Bank 2)
DESCRIPTION
The VVT sensor consists of a magnet, an iron core and a pick-up coil. This sensor monitors a timing rotor
located on the camshaft and is used by the ECM to detect the camshaft angle. The camshaft rotation
synchronizes with the crankshaft rotation, and this sensor communicates the rotation of the camshaft
timing rotor as a pulse signal to the ECM.
If there is no signal from the VVT sensor even though the engine is turning or the rotation of the camshaft
and the crankshaft is not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the sensor and sets a
DTC.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
Trouble Area
No VVT sensor signal to ECM during cranking (2 trip
detection logic)
No VVT sensor signal to ECM with engine speed 600
rpm or more (1 trip detection logic)
P0340
P0345
•
P0341
P0346
While crankshaft rotates twice, VVT sensor signal is input
to ECM 12 times or more (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Intake camshaft
Timing belt has a jumped tooth
ECM
Same as DTC No. P0340/P0345
HINT:
• DTC P0340 and P0345 indicate a malfunction related to the VVT sensor (+) circuit
(wire harness (from ECM to VVT sensor) and VVT sensor).
• DTC P0341 and P0346 indicate a malfunction related to the VVT sensor (-) circuit
(wire harness (from ECM to VVT sensor) and VVT sensor).
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
2 V/DIV.
VV1+
Ground
VV2+
Ground
NE+
Ground
20 msec./DIV. (idling)
A106052E02
Reference: Inspect using an oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector.
ES
ES–204
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VV1+ (E6-25) - VV1- (E6-24)
Correct waveform is as shown
VV2+ (E6-18) - VV2- (E6-28)
Correct waveform is as shown
NE+ (E6-21) - NE- (E6-20)
Correct waveform is as shown
G2+ (E6-19) - G2- (E6-29)
Correct waveform is as shown
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the VVT sensor even though the engine is revolving, or if the rotation of the
camshaft and the crankshaft is not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0340: VVT sensor (bank 1) range check / rationality
P0341: VVT sensor (bank 1) range check / rationality
P0345: VVT sensor (bank 2) range check / rationality
P0346: VVT sensor (bank 2) range check / rationality
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
VVT sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
5 seconds
MIL Operation
P0340, P0345 case 1: 2 driving cycles
P0340, P0345 case 2, P0341, P0346: Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
P0340, P0345 Case 1:
Starter
ON
Minimal battery voltage while starter ON
Less than 11 V
P0340, P0345 Case 2:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
P0341, P0346:
Starter
After OFF to ON timing
Engine revolution
720°CA
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0340, P0345 Case 1:
VVT sensor signal
No signal
P0340, P0345 Case 2:
VVT sensor signal
No signal
P0341, P0346:
VVT sensor count
12 or more / 720°CA (=Engine 2 revolutions)
ES–205
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VVT sensor signal input during every 720°CA
3
WIRING DIAGRAM
V4
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
ECM
Shielded
1
R
18
VV2+
E6
2
G
28
VV2E6
V3
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
ES
Shielded
1
Y
25
VV1+
E6
2
L
24
VV1E6
W-B
W-B
E
E
J28
J/C
ED
A130711E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
ES–206
1
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT VVT SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the V3 and V4 VVT sensor connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the VVT sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side:
VVT Sensor
V3
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω
1-2
Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
V4
Front View
A066132E08
ES
HINT:
In the above chart, the terms "cold" and "hot" refer to the
temperature of the coils.
"Cold" means approximately -10 to 50°C (14 to 122°F).
"Hot" means approximately 50 to 100°C (122 to 212°F).
NG
REPLACE VVT SENSOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VVT SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V3 or V4 VVT sensor connectors.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
VVT Sensor Connector
Tester Connection
V3
Specified Condition
VVT sensor (V3-1) - VV1+ (E6-25)
V4
VVT sensor (V3-2) - VV1- (E6-24)
VVT sensor (V4-1) - VV2+ (E6-18)
Front View
Below 1 Ω
VVT sensor (V4-2) - VV2- (E6-28)
E6
ECM Connector
VVT sensor (V3-1) or VV1+ (E6-25) Body ground
VVT sensor (V3-2) or VV1- (E6-24) Body ground
VVT sensor (V4-1) or VV2+ (E6-18) Body ground
VV2+
VV1+
VV2VV1-
10 kΩ or higher
VVT sensor (V4-2) or VV2- (E6-28) Body ground
(d) Reconnect the VVT sensor connectors.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
A115706E02
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
ES–207
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (VVT SENSOR)
(a) Check the sensor installation.
OK:
Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
OK
SECURELY REINSTALL SENSOR
NG
BR03795E15
ES
OK
4
CHECK CAMSHAFT (TOOTH)
(a) Remove the cylinder head cover (See page EM-107 ).
(b) Check the tooth of the camshaft.
OK:
The camshaft does not have any cracks or deformation.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE CAMSHAFT
ES–208
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0351
Ignition Coil "A" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0352
Ignition Coil "B" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0353
Ignition Coil "C" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0354
Ignition Coil "D" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0355
Ignition Coil "E" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0356
Ignition Coil "F" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0357
Ignition Coil "G" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0358
Ignition Coil "H" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• These DTCs indicate a malfunction related to a primary circuit.
• If DTC P0351 is displayed, check No. 1 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0352 is displayed, check No. 2 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0353 is displayed, check No. 3 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0354 is displayed, check No. 4 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0355 is displayed, check No. 5 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0356 is displayed, check No. 6 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0357 is displayed, check No. 7 ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0358 is displayed, check No. 8 ignition coil circuit.
A Direct Ignition System (DIS) is used on this vehicle.
The DIS is a 1-cylinder ignition system which ignites one cylinder with one ignition coil. In the 1-cylinder
ignition system, the one spark plug is connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage
generated in the secondary winding is applied directly to the spark plug. The spark of the spark plug
passes from the center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines the ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGTs) for each cylinder. Using the
IGTs, the ECM turns the power transistor inside the igniter on/off, which switches on/off current to the
primary coil. When current to the primary coil is cut off, high voltage is generated in the secondary coil and
this voltage is applied to the spark plugs to create sparks inside the cylinders. As the ECM cuts current to
the primary coil, the igniter sends back ignition confirmation signals (IGFs) for each cylinder ignition to the
ECM.
ES–209
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
No. 1 Ignition Coil with Igniter
From Battery
ECM
Igniter
IGT1
No. 1 Cylinder
IGF1
Ignition Coil
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
IGT2
No. 2 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 2 Cylinder
IGF2
ES
IGT3
No. 3 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 3 Cylinder
IGT4
No. 4 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 4 Cylinder
IGT5
No. 5 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 5 Cylinder
IGT6
No. 6 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 6 Cylinder
IGT7
No. 7 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 7 Cylinder
IGT8
No. 8 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
No. 8 Cylinder
Camshaft Position
Sensor
Other Sensor
(Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor,
Mass Air Flow Meter, Throttle
Position Sensor, etc.)
TAC
to Tachometer
A117778E04
ES–210
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
P0355
P0356
P0357
P0358
Trouble Area
•
•
No IGF signal to ECM while engine is running
•
•
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit (1 to 8) between
ignition coil with igniter and ECM
No. 1 to No. 8 ignition coil (primary ignition)
ECM
2 V/DIV.
CH 1
Ground
CH 2
Ground
ES
20 msec./DIV.
A093278E13
Reference: Inspect using an oscilloscope.
While cranking or idling the engine, check the waveform between terminals IGT1 to IGT8 and E1, and
IGF1 to IGF2 and E1 of the E6, E8 and E6 ECM connectors.
Items
Terminals
Contents
CH1: IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5,
IGT6, IGT7, IGT8 - E1
CH2: IGF1, IGF2 - E1
Equipment Settings
2 V/DIV.
20 msec./DIV.
Condition
While the engine is cranking or idling
ES–211
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Coil with Igniter
IGT
Ignition Coil
ECM
Igniter
IGF
ES
Ignition Signal (IGT)
Ignition
Confirmation
Signal (IGF)
Normal
Open
Open
Time
A082388E19
If the ECM does not receive an IGF after sending an IGT, it interprets this as a fault in the igniter and sets
a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0351: Igniter (cylinder 1) malfunction
P0352: Igniter (cylinder 2) malfunction
P0353: Igniter (cylinder 3) malfunction
P0354: Igniter (cylinder 4) malfunction
P0355: Igniter (cylinder 5) malfunction
P0356: Igniter (cylinder 6) malfunction
P0357: Igniter (cylinder 7) malfunction
P0358: Igniter (cylinder 8) malfunction
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Igniter
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.256 seconds + 4 sparks
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Either of the following condition is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Starter
OFF
2. Engine RPM
1,500 rpm or less
Either of the following condition is met:
Condition (a) or (b)
ES–212
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a) All of the following conditions are met:
-
Engine RPM
500 rpm or less
Battery voltage
6 V or more
(b) All of the following conditions are met:
-
Engine RPM
More than 500 rpm
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Number of sparks after CPU is reset
5 sparks or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ES
Ignition signal fail count
More than 2 times
Ignition signal fail count
When IGF does not return despite sending IGT
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
IGF signal
Igniter outputs IGF signal when it receives IGT signal from ECM
ES–213
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
I1 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 1
B-R
B-R
B-R
ECM
B-R
LG
1
3
W-B 4
2
R-Y
1 EB1
I3 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 3
W-B
R-Y
L-W
B-R
B-R
1
W-B 4
B-Y
R-Y
8
E4 IGT1
24
E4 IGF1
3 R-W
2
11
E4 IGT3
I5 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 5
W-B
7 EA1
2
B-R
N1
Noise
Filter
(Ignition
No. 1)
B-R
1
B-R
W-B 4
B-R
1
IG2
1
I18
Ignition SW
W-B 4
2
R-W
W-B
7
N2
Noise
Filter
(Ignition
No. 2)
Engine
Room
R/B
2
2
LG-B
B-R
R
2
1
3
W-B 4
2
B-R
1
W-B 4
R-W
R-W
L-Y
L-Y
10
E4 IGT4
G
12
E4 IGT6
G-B
9
E4 IGT8
3 R-Y
2
I6 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 6
1
1
W-B
2
B-R
1
W-B
W-B 4
W-B
3 R-Y
2
I8 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 8
B
W-B
B-R
1
B
Battery
EC
ER
ED
15
E4 IGT2
25
E4 IGF2
I4 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 4
W-B
AM2
14
E4 IGT7
3 R-Y
I2 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 2
AM2
G-W
3 R-W
2
I7 Ignition Coil and
Igniter No. 7
W-B
6
B-L
13
E4 IGT5
W-B
ED
W-B
4
3 R-W
2
A133712E01
ES
ES–214
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
• If DTCs P0351, P0354, P0356 and P0357 are output simultaneously, IGF1 circuit may be open or
short.
• If DTCs P0352, P0353, P0355 and P0358 are output simultaneously, IGF2 circuit may be open or
short.
1
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
ES
(a) Check the spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder (See
page IG-1).
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL - ECM [IGF SIGNAL TERMINAL])
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 or I8 ignition coil
with igniter connectors.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
Tester Connection
I7
I8
Ignition coil (I1-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Ignition Coil with Igniter Connector
Ignition coil (I2-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Ignition coil (I3-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Ignition coil (I4-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
E4
Specified Condition
Ignition coil (I5-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Below 1 Ω
Ignition coil (I6-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Ignition coil (I7-2) - IGF1 (E4-24)
Ignition coil (I8-2) - IGF2 (E4-25)
Ignition coil (I1-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) Body ground
IGF1
IGF2
ECM Connector
Ignition coil (I2-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) Body ground
A115891E02
Ignition coil (I3-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) Body ground
Ignition coil (I4-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) Body ground
Ignition coil (I5-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) Body ground
Ignition coil (I6-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) Body ground
Ignition coil (I7-2) or IGF1 (E4-24) Body ground
Ignition coil (I8-2) or IGF2 (E4-25) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ES–215
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connectors.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (IGF1 AND IGF2 VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
E4
IGF2 (+)
E6
IGF1 (+)
E1 (-)
(a) Disconnect the ignition coil with igniter connectors.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage of the E4 and E6 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGF1 (E4-24) - E1 (E6-1)
4.5 to 5.5 V
IGF2 (E4-25) - E1 (E6-1)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connectors.
E118245E24
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL WITH IGNITER
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL - ECM [IGT SIGNAL TERMINAL])
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 or I8 ignition coil
with igniter connectors.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
Tester Connection
IGT (I1-3) - IGT1 (E4-8)
Ignition Coil with Igniter Connector
IGT (I2-3) - IGT2 (E4-15)
IGT (I3-3) - IGT3 (E4-11)
IGT (I4-3) - IGT4 (E4-10)
E4
IGT (I5-3) - IGT5 (E4-13)
IGT (I6-3) - IGT6 (E4-12)
IGT (I7-3) - IGT7 (E4-14)
IGT2
IGT7
IGT5
Specified Condition
IGT (I8-3) - IGT8 (E4-9)
IGT1
IGT8
IGT4
IGT3 ECM
IGT6
Connector
A115891E03
Below 1 Ω
ES
ES–216
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGT (I1-3) or IGT1 (E4-8) - Body
ground
IGT (I2-3) or IGT2 (E4-15) - Body
ground
IGT (I3-3) or IGT3 (E4-11) - Body
ground
IGT (I4-3) or IGT4 (E4-10) - Body
ground
IGT (I5-3) or IGT5 (E4-13) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT (I6-3) or IGT6 (E4-12) - Body
ground
IGT (I7-3) or IGT7 (E4-14) - Body
ground
IGT (I8-3) or IGT8 (E4-9) - Body
ground
ES
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connectors.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
INSPECT ECM (IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5, IGT6, IGT7 OR IGT8 VOLTAGE)
IGT3 (+)
IGT4 (+)
IGT8 (+)
(a) Measure the voltage of the E4 and E6 ECM connectors
when the engine is cranked.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
IGT1 (+)
Specified Condition
IGT1 (E4-8) - E1 (E6-1)
E4
IGT2 (E4-15) - E1 (E6-1)
E6
IGT3 (E4-11) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT4 (E4-10) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT5 (E4-13) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT6 (E4-12) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT2 (+)
IGT7 (E4-14) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT5 (+) IGT6 (+) E1 (-)
IGT8 (E4-9) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT7 (+)
A116425E08
OK
NG
REPLACE ECM
0.1 to 4.5 V
ES–217
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6
INSPECT ECM (IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5, IGT6, IGT7 OR IGT8 VOLTAGE)
IGT3 (+)
IGT4 (+)
IGT8 (+)
IGT1 (+)
E4
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 or I8 ignition coil
with igniter connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage of the E4 and E6 ECM connectors
when the engine is cranked.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
E6
Specified Condition
IGT1 (E4-8) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT2 (E4-15) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT3 (E4-11) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT4 (E4-10) - E1 (E6-1)
4.5 V or more
IGT5 (E4-13) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT5 (+) IGT6 (+) E1 (-)
IGT2 (+)
IGT6 (E4-12) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT7 (E4-14) - E1 (E6-1)
IGT7 (+)
IGT8 (E4-9) - E1 (E6-1)
A116425E08
(c) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connectors.
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
7
INSPECT IGNITION COIL WITH IGNITER (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 and I8 ignition coil
with igniter connectors.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON or START.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector
and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
Tester Connection
+B
Ignition Coil with Igniter Connector
Specified Condition
+B (I1-1) - Body ground
+B (I2-1) - Body ground
A054393E46
+B (I3-1) - Body ground
+B (I4-1) - Body ground
+B (I5-1) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
+B (I6-1) - Body ground
+B (I7-1) - Body ground
+B (I8-1) - Body ground
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil connectors.
OK
NG
REPLACE IGNITION COIL
ES
ES–218
8
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL - IGNITION SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3, I4, I5, I6, I7 or I8 ignition coil
with igniter connectors.
(b) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
I1
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Ignition coil (I1-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Ignition coil (I2-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Ignition Coil with Igniter
Ignition coil (I3-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Ignition coil (I4-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
ES
Ignition coil (I5-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Below 1 Ω
Ignition coil (I6-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
I18
Ignition coil (I7-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Ignition coil (I8-1) - IG2 (I18-6)
Ignition coil (I1-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
Ignition Switch
IG2
A115892E01
Ignition coil (I2-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
Ignition coil (I3-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
Ignition coil (I4-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
Ignition coil (I5-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Ignition coil (I6-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
Ignition coil (I7-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
Ignition coil (I8-1) or IG2 (I18-6) Body ground
(d) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
(e) Reconnect the ignition coil with igniter connectors.
NG
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–219
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0412
Secondary Air Injection System Switching
Valve "A" Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The Secondary Air Injection (AIR) system pumps air to the exhaust port to accelerate the activation of the
catalyst. The secondary air injection system consists of the ECM, air pump, Air Switching Valve (ASV)
(EASV), No. 2 Air Switching Valve (No. 2 ASV) (ASV1, 2), pressure sensor and Air Injection Control
Driver (AID). The Air Switching Valve (ASV) (EASV) is an electromagnetic type and No. 2 Air Switching
Valve (No. 2 ASV)(ASV1, 2) is a vacuum type.
The secondary air injection system pumps pressurized air to the exhaust port by the air pump through the
ASV and No. 2 ASV. The ASV assists the No. 2 ASV. The No. 2 ASV also controls air supply.
The ECM sends signals to the AID, and then the AID operates the air pump and ASV. The pressure
sensor detects pressure and exhaust pulsation in the system when the system operates and when it does
not operate, and sends the data to the ECM.
Air Switching Valve
(ASV) (EASV)
To Bank 1
No. 2 Air Switching Valve
(No. 2 ASV) (ASV1)
Pressure Sensor
Engine Coolant
Temperature
Sensor
Air Pump
Air
ECM
To Bank 2
VSV (for Air
Injection system)
Air Injection
Control
Driver (AID)
Mass Air Flow
Meter
Intake Air
Temperature
Sensor
No. 2 Air Switching Valve
(No. 2 ASV) (ASV2)
A115362E02
ES
ES–220
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0412
Both of the following conditions are met when engine is
idling just after cold start
(1 trip detection logic):
1. Air injection (AIR) system does not operate (Air pump
OFF and all ASVs OFF)
2. Air injection control driver (AID) diagnostic signal duty
is 40 %
P0412
Both of the following conditions are met when engine is
idling just after cold start
(1 trip detection logic):
1. Air injection (AIR) system operates (Air pump ON and
all ASVs ON)
2. Air injection control driver (AID) diagnostic signal duty
is 40 %
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open in air switching valve drive circuit
Short between air switching valve circuit and +B
circuit
Air injection control driver (AID)
Air switching valve (ASV)
ECM
Short between air switching valve circuit and body
ground
AID
ASV
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Air Injection Control Driver (AID) detects an open or short in the circuit according to the voltage of the
air pump terminal (VP) and electromagnetic air switching valve terminal (VV), and sends a signal as
diagnostic information to the ECM.
The AID outputs the air switching valve terminal malfunction signal to the ECM if: 1) VV terminal voltage is
low despite the AID receiving the command signal from the ECM to drive the air switching valve terminal
or 2) VV terminal voltage is high despite the AID not receiving the command signal from the ECM.
The ECM stores the DTC based on the diagnostic signal from the AID and illuminates the MIL.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0412: Air switching valve circuit malfunction (Secondary air injection system)
Required sensors/components
Air injection control driver, Air switching valve
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
None
Case 1:
Air pump
Operating
Air switching valve
Operating
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
Case 2:
Air pump
Not operating
Air switching valve
Not operating
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–221
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1, 2:
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection driver
31 to 48 %
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
70 to 90 % when secondary air injection system operating
and
0 % when secondary air injection system not operating
ES
ES–222
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
35
IC4
W-G
8
E8 MREL
W-G
V13 VSV
J4
J/C
L-W
A
17
L-W
IC3
L-W
A
2
2
ES
J28
J/C
EFI Engine Room
No. 2 R/B
B
B
2
2
2
EFI
Relay
2
A/PUMP
1
5
2
2
Engine Room
R/B
2
V12 VSV
2
2
L
26
E4 AIV2
2
VP A43
G
G
25
E8 AIRP
Y
Y
4
E8 AIRV
V
V
13
E8 AIDI
2
4
IC3
14
IC3
10
IC3
L
4
EA1
G
3
EA1
4
IN1
L
BR
1
2
B
2
L
1
A44 E
BR
ALT
2
W-B
1
1
3
5
SIV A44
A44 +B
2
1
DI A44
R
A43 BATT
Engine Room
6
R/B
VV A44
B
3
27
E4 AIV1
P
L-W
4
SIP A44
2
1
L-W
(Air Switching Valve Bank 1)
Air Injection
Control Driver
1
2
(Air Switching Valve Bank 2)
12
L-W
L-W
IM1
C
D
C
D
L-W
G
A J35
Engine
Room
R/B
J/C
E J36
BR
EFI
1
1
2
A46
Air Pump
1
A47
Air Switching
Valve
2
W-B
W-B
9 IM2
2
B J2
J/C
B J3
W-B
EB
BR
B
W-B
Battery
ED
EQ
A133715E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–223
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The diagnostic information output from Air Injection Control Driver (AID) can be confirmed by connecting
an oscilloscope to the diagnostic information terminal of the AID. It narrows a trouble area search to read
the waveform on the oscilloscope when performing the AIR system intrusive operation function provided
in the SYSTEM CHECK.
1. Start the engine and warm it up.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
4. Connect an oscilloscope probe to the AIDI terminal of the ECM.
ECM Connector
ES
E1
AIDI
G035614E71
5. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
6. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR
INJ CHECK / MANUAL OPERATION / OPERATION 1 and 2.
AIR INJ CHECK
AIR PUMP
ON
EASV
OPEN
ASV1
OPEN
ASV2
OPEN
A/F BANK1
19.05
A/F BANK2
19.05
PRESSURE
17 kPa-g
PULSATION
25.39 kPa-g
AI STATUS
OK
Remaining Time 05 sec.
Press[EXIT]to quit
G032717E01
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF; EASV: CLOSE; ASV1: CLOSE; ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 2: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: OPEN; ASV2: OPEN
7. Monitor the voltage output of the AID (duty ratio signal).
Example: 80% Duty Signal
5 V/DIV.
GND
20 msec./DIV.
A116420E03
ES–224
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Oscilloscope range
Items
ES
Contents
Terminals
CH1: AIDI - E1
Equipment Settings
5 V/DIV., 20 to 40 ms/DIV.
Conditions
Idling
NOTICE:
• This AIR INJECTION CHECK only allows technicians to operate the AIR system for 5 seconds.
Furthermore, the check can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated, intervals of at
least 30 seconds are required between checks.
While the AIR system operation using the intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays the
prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• Performing the AIR INJ CHECK over and over again may cause damage in the secondary air
injection system. If necessary, wait several minutes between tests to prevent overheating the
system.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation after the battery cable has been reconnected,
wait for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ CHECK operation finishes.
AID Diagnostic Signal
Waveform
ECM Command
DTC
(ECM Output)
Suspected Trouble Area
•
•
100 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 1
Any Air Injection (AIR) System
operation
P1613
•
•
•
0 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 2
AIR System: ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
P1613
•
•
•
•
AIR System: OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
-
•
P0418
•
•
•
20 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 3
•
Air Pump: OFF
P0418
Open or short in air pump or
Air Switching Valve (ASV)
command signal circuit (ECM
- AID)
Open in AID ground circuit
Short between diagnostic
signal circuit and body
ground
AID
ECM
Normal
•
Air Pump: ON
Open in diagnostic signal
circuit
Air Injection Control Driver
(AID)
Open in AID +B circuit (AID
power source)
Short between +B circuit and
diagnostic signal circuit
•
•
•
•
Short between air pump drive
circuit and body ground
Harness & connector (AID Pump)
Air Pump
AID
ECM
Open in air pump drive circuit
(AID - Pump), or short
between air pump drive
circuit and +B
Harness & connector (AID Pump)
Air Pump
AID
ECM
ES–225
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
AID Diagnostic Signal
Waveform
DTC
(ECM Output)
ECM Command
Suspected Trouble Area
•
•
ASV: ON
P0412
•
•
•
40 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 4
•
ASV: OFF
80 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 5
Excluding Above
(excluding 0, 20, 40, 80, 100 %
duty)
P0412
Short between ASV drive
circuit and body ground
Harness & connector (AID ASV)
ASV
AID
ECM
•
•
•
Open in ASV drive circuit
(AID - ASV), or short between
ASV drive circuit and +B
Harness & connector (AID ASV)
AID
ASV
ECM
AID
ECM
•
AIR System: OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
P1613
•
•
AIR System: ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
-
Normal
-
P1613
•
•
1.
Waveform 1
100 % Duty Ratio
2.
Waveform 2
0 % Duty Ratio
3.
Waveform 3
20 % Duty Ratio
Almost Same as Battery Voltage
+B
GND
A112066E01
+B
Fixed at Low Voltage
GND
A112067E01
20%
+B
GND
A112068E01
AID
Open in AID ground circuit
ES
ES–226
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
Waveform 4
40 % Duty Ratio
5.
Waveform 5
80 % Duty Ratio
40%
+B
GND
A112069E01
80%
ES
+B
GND
A112070E01
HINT:
• Using the AIR INJ CHECK operation of the SYSTEM CHECK provided in the intelligent tester function,
conditions for air fuel ratio and pressure in the secondary air injection system passage can be checked
while the secondary air injection system is operating. It helps technicians to troubleshoot the system
when it is malfunctioning.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
INSPECT AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Disconnect the A47 Air Switching Valve (ASV)
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the ASV.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A47
ASV Connector
Specified Condition
1-2
4.5 to 5.5 Ω
(d) Reconnect the ASV connector.
G037724E07
OK
Tester Connection
NG
REPLACE AIR SWITCHING VALVE
ES–227
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR SWITCHING VALVE - BODY GROUND)
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Disconnect the A47 ASV connector.
(c) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
A47
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A47-2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reconnect the ASV connector.
ASV Connector
A056870E27
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR SWITCHING VALVE - AIR INJECTION
CONTROL DRIVER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Control Driver Connector
A44
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
Disconnect the A44 air injection driver connector.
Disconnect the A47 air switching valve connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VV (A44-6) - A47-1
Below 1 Ω
VV (A44-6) or A47-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VV
(e) Reconnect the air injection driver connector.
(f) Reconnect the ASV connector.
Air Switching Valve Connector
NG
A47
A121615E03
OK
REPLACE AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–228
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0418
Secondary Air Injection System Control "A"
Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-214).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0418
Both of the following conditions are met, when idling just after
cold start (1 trip detection logic):
1. Air injection (AIR) system does not operate
2. Air injection control driver (AID) outputs air pump
malfunction signal (20% duty signal)
•
•
•
•
Open in air pump drive circuit
Short between air pump circuit and +B circuit
Air injection control driver (AID)
ECM
P0418
Both of the following conditions are met, when idling just after
cold start (1 trip detection logic):
1. Air injection (AIR) system operates
2. Air injection control driver (AID) outputs air pump
malfunction signal (20% duty signal)
•
•
•
Short between air pump circuit and body ground
AID
ECM
ES
Trouble Area
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Air Injection Control Driver (AID) detects an open or short in the air pump and Air Switching Valve (ASV)
circuit according to the terminal voltage and sends a signal as diagnostic information to the ECM.
When the air injection system operation is required while the engine is warming up, the ECM transmits
command signals to the AID to drive the air pump and ASV.
The AID outputs the air pump malfunction signal to the ECM if: 1) VP terminal voltage is low despite the
AID receiving the command signal from the ECM to drive the air pump or 2) VP terminal voltage is high
despite the AID not receiving the command signal from the ECM.
The ECM sets the DTC based on the diagnostic information from the AID.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0418: Air pump range check
Required sensors/components
Air injection control driver, Air pump
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
None
Case 1:
Air pump
Operating
Air switching valve
Operating
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
Case 2:
Air pump
Not operating
Air switching valve
Not operating
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–229
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1, 2:
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
11 to 29 %
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
70 to 90 % when secondary air injection system operating
and
0 % when secondary air injection system not operating
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-217).
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The diagnostic information output from the AID can be confirmed by connecting an oscilloscope to the
diagnostic information terminal of the AID. It narrows the trouble area search to read the waveform on the
oscilloscope when performing the AIR system intrusive operation function provided in the SYSTEM
CHECK.
1. Start the engine and warm it up.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM
4. Connect an oscilloscope probe to the AIDI terminal of the ECM.
ECM Connector
E1
AIDI
G035614E71
5. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
6. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR
INJ SYSTEM.
7. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR
INJ CHECK / MANUAL OPERATION / OPERATION 1 and 2.
AIR INJ CHECK
AIR PUMP
ON
EASV
OPEN
ASV1
OPEN
ASV2
OPEN
A/F BANK1
19.05
A/F BANK2
19.05
PRESSURE
17 kPa-g
PULSATION
25.39 kPa-g
AI STATUS
OK
Remaining Time 05 sec.
Press[EXIT]to quit
G032717E01
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF; EASV: CLOSE; ASV1: CLOSE; ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 2: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: OPEN; ASV2: OPEN
ES–230
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8. Monitor the voltage output of the AID (duty ratio signal).
Example: 80% Duty Signal
5 V/DIV.
GND
20 msec./DIV.
ES
A116420E03
Oscilloscope range
Items
Contents
Terminals
CH1: AIDI - E1
Equipment Settings
5 V/DIV., 20 to 40 ms/DIV.
Conditions
Idling
NOTICE:
• This AIR INJECTION CHECK only allows technicians to operate the AIR system for 5
seconds.
Furthermore, the check can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated, intervals of at
least 30 seconds are required between checks.
While the AIR system operation using the intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (AI STATUS NG) or ERROR. If ERROR (AI STATUS NG) is displayed on the
tester, stop the engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• Performing the AIR INJ CHECK over and over again may cause damage in the secondary air
injection system. If necessary, wait several minutes between tests to prevent overheating the
system.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation after the battery cable has been
reconnected, wait for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ CHECK operation finishes.
AID Diagnostic Signal
Waveform
ECM Command
DTC
(ECM Output)
Suspected Trouble Area
•
•
100 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 1
Any Air Injection (AIR) System
operation
P1613
•
•
Open in diagnostic signal
circuit
Air Injection Control Driver
(AID)
Open in AID +B circuit (AID
power source)
Short between +B circuit and
diagnostic signal circuit
ES–231
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
AID Diagnostic Signal
Waveform
DTC
(ECM Output)
ECM Command
Suspected Trouble Area
•
0 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 2
AIR System: ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
P1613
•
•
•
•
AIR System: OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
-
Normal
•
•
Air Pump: ON
P0418
•
•
•
20 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 3
•
Air Pump: OFF
P0418
•
•
•
•
•
•
ASV: ON
P0412
•
•
•
40 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 4
•
ASV: OFF
80 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 5
Excluding Above
(excluding 0, 20, 40, 80, 100 %
duty)
P0412
Open or short in air pump or
Air Switching Valve (ASV)
command signal circuit (ECM
- AID)
Open in AID ground circuit
Short between diagnostic
signal circuit and body
ground
AID
ECM
Short between air pump drive
circuit and body ground
Harness & connector (AID Pump)
Air Pump
AID
ECM
Open in air pump drive circuit
(AID - Pump), or short
between air pump drive
circuit and +B
Harness & connector (AID Pump)
Air Pump
AID
ECM
Short between ASV drive
circuit and body ground
Harness & connector (AID ASV)
ASV
AID
ECM
•
•
•
Open in ASV drive circuit
(AID - ASV), or short between
ASV drive circuit and +B
Harness & connector (AID ASV)
AID
ASV
ECM
AID
ECM
•
AIR System: OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
P1613
•
•
AIR System: ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
-
Normal
-
P1613
•
•
1.
Almost Same as Battery Voltage
+B
GND
A112066E01
Waveform 1
100 % Duty Ratio
AID
Open in AID ground circuit
ES
ES–232
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2.
Waveform 2
0 % Duty Ratio
3.
Waveform 3
20 % Duty Ratio
4.
Waveform 4
40 % Duty Ratio
5.
Waveform 5
80 % Duty Ratio
+B
Fixed at Low Voltage
GND
A112067E01
20%
ES
+B
GND
A112068E01
40%
+B
GND
A112069E01
80%
+B
GND
A112070E01
HINT:
• Using the AIR INJ CHECK operation of the SYSTEM CHECK provided in the intelligent tester function,
conditions for air fuel ratio and pressure in the secondary air injection system passage can be checked
while the secondary air injection system is operating. It helps technicians to troubleshoot the system
when it is malfunctioning.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–233
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
INSPECT AIR PUMP
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Disconnect the A46 air pump connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the air pump.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A46
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
0.4 to 1.0 Ω
(d) Reconnect the air pump connector.
G032723E03
NG
REPLACE AIR PUMP
ES
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR PUMP - BODY GROUND)
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Disconnect the A46 air pump connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors and body ground.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
A46
Air Pump Connector
Specified Condition
A46-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reconnect the air pump connector.
G032722E05
OK
Tester Connection
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–234
3
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER - AIR PUMP)
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Control Driver Connector
A43
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
Disconnect the A43 air injection driver connector.
Disconnect the A46 air pump connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
VP
Specified Condition
VP (A43-2) - A46-2
Below 1 Ω
VP (A43-2) or A46-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(e) Reconnect the air injection driver connector.
(f) Reconnect the air pump connector.
ES
Air Pump Connector
NG
A46
A121616E02
OK
REPLACE AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–235
DTC
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Bank 1)
DTC
P0430
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Bank 2)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses sensors mounted in front of and behind the Three-way Catalytic Converter (TWC) to
monitor its efficiency.
The first sensor, the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, sends pre-catalyst information to the ECM. The second
sensor, the Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor, sends post-catalyst information to the ECM.
In order to detect any deterioration in the TWC, the ECM calculates the Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC)
of the TWC. This calculation is based on the voltage output of the HO2 sensor while performing active airfuel ratio control, rather than the conventional detecting method, which uses the locus ratio.
The OSC value is an indication of the oxygen storage capacity of the TWC. When the vehicle is being
driven with a warm engine, active air fuel ratio control is performed for approximately 15 to 20 seconds.
When it is performed, the ECM deliberately sets the air fuel ratio to lean or rich levels. If a rich-lean cycle
of the HO2 sensor is long, the OSC becomes greater. There is a direct correlation between the OSCs of
the HO2 sensor and the TWC.
The ECM uses the OSC value to determine the state of the TWC. If any deterioration has occurred, it
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0420
OSC value smaller than standard value under active air
fuel ratio control
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
P0430
OSC value smaller than standard value under active air
fuel ratio control
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Gas leakage from exhaust system
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) (Exhaust
manifold)
Gas leakage from exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
HO2 sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) (Exhaust
manifold)
HINT:
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes No. 1 cylinder.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include No. 1 cylinder.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0420: Catalyst (Bank 1) detection
P0430: Catalyst (Bank 2) detection
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Catalyst
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Heated oxygen sensor, Intake air temperature sensor, Mass air flow
meter, Crankshaft position sensor, Engine coolant temperature sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
About 30 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
ES–236
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
ES
P0011 (VVT System 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT System 1 - Retard)
P0021 (VVT System 2 - Advance)
P0022 (VVT System 2 - Retard)
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 (HO2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0136, P0156 (HO2 Sensor - Sensor 2)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0308 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0351 - P0358 (Igniter)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor - rationality)
P2237, P2240 (A/F sensor - open)
P2440 (AIR control valve stuck open)
P2441 (AIR control valve stuck close)
P2444 (AIP stuck ON)
P2445 (AIP stuck OFF)
P2A00, P2A03 (A/F sensor - slow response)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Intake air temperature
-10°C (14°F) or more
Engine coolant temperature
75°C (167°F) or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine RPM
Less than 3,200 rpm
A/F sensor
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
Engine load
10 to 70 %
All of the following conditions are met
Conditions 1, 2 and 3
1. MAF
6 to 75 g/sec. (Varies with engine RPM)
2. Front catalyst temperature (estimated)
715 to 830°C (1,319 to 1,526°F)
3. Rear catalyst temperature (estimated)
410 to 830°C (770 to 1,526°F)
EVAP system monitor
The monitor has not run yet or the vacuum introduction has been
completed
A/F sensor monitor
Completed
Rear HO2S heater monitor
Completed
Shift position
4th or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Oxygen storage capacity (OSC) of catalyst
Less than 0.08 g
MONITOR RESULT
Detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
CONDITIONING FOR SENSOR TESTING
HINT:
Perform the operation with the engine speeds and time durations described below prior to checking the
waveforms of the A/F and HO2 sensors. This is in order to activate the sensors sufficiently to obtain the
appropriate inspection results.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–237
Engine Speed
[C]
3,000 rpm
[D]
2,000 rpm
[B]
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
[D]
[A]
Time
Warming up
At least 3 minutes
Check
2 seconds
A118003E05
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM [A].
2. Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories switched OFF, until the engine coolant
temperature stabilizes [B].
3. Run the engine at an engine speed of between 2,500 rpm and 3,000 rpm for at least 3 minutes [C].
4. While running the engine at 3,000 rpm for 2 seconds and 2,000 rpm for 2 seconds, check the
waveforms of the A/F and HO2 sensors using the tester [D].
HINT:
• If either of voltage outputs of the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) or Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensors does not
fluctuate, or either of the sensors makes a noise, the sensor may be malfunctioning.
• If the voltage outputs of both the sensors remain lean or rich, the air fuel ratio may be extremely lean
or rich. In such cases, perform the following A/F CONTROL using the intelligent tester.
• If the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) has deteriorated, the HO2 sensor (located behind the
TWC) voltage output fluctuates up and down frequently, even under normal driving conditions
(active air fuel ratio control is not performed).
ES
ES–238
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Voltage output when active air-fuel ratio control not performed
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of
A/F Sensor in
front of TWC
Deteriorated Catalyst
3.5 V
3.0 V
Waveform of
HO2 Sensor
behind TWC
ES
1.0 V
0V
10 seconds
10 seconds
A121610E01
1.
A/F CONTROL
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the
ACTIVE TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor, Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or
LEFT button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the voltage outputs of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1
and O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection
volume by 25%.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
ES–239
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NOTICE:
The Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
1
2
3
4
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check and graph the output
voltages of both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, enter the following menus on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2. Then press the YES button and ENTER button, followed by the F4 button.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0420 AND/OR P0430)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
ES
ES–240
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0420 and/or P0430
A
P0420 and/or P0430 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0420 or P0430 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/F CONTROL)
ES
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for
approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in
an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT button to
change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the output voltages of the A/F and HO2 sensors
(AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2)
displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection
volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume by
25 %.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and
decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25%
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5%
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25%
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5%
Lean
Less than 0.4
Result:
Status
AFS B1S1
or
AFS B2S1
Status
O2S B1S2
or
O2S B2S2
A/F Condition and
A/F and
HO2 Sensor
Conditions
Main Suspected
Trouble Areas
Misfire
•
Lean/Rich
Lean/Rich
Normal
•
Lean
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor
malfunction
-
•
Proceed to
Three-Way
Catalytic
Converter (TWC)
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
A
A/F sensor
B
ES–241
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Status
AFS B1S1
or
AFS B2S1
Status
O2S B1S2
or
O2S B2S2
A/F Condition and
A/F and
HO2 Sensor
Conditions
Misfire
Rich
Lean/Rich
A/F sensor
malfunction
May occur
•
A/F sensor
B
Lean/Rich
Lean
HO2 sensor
malfunction
-
•
•
HO2 sensor
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
C
Lean/Rich
Rich
HO2 sensor
malfunction
-
•
•
HO2 sensor
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
C
•
Lean
Actual air fuel ratio
lean
Extremely rich or
lean actual air
fuel ratio
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
A
Extremely rich or
lean actual air
fuel ratio
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
A
Lean
Main Suspected
Trouble Areas
May occur
•
•
Rich
Rich
Actual air fuel ratio
lean
•
Proceed to
ES
Lean: During A/F CONTROL, the A/F sensor (AFS) output
voltage is consistently more than 3.35 V, and the HO2
sensor output voltage (O2S) is consistently less than 0.4
V.
Rich: During A/F CONTROL, the AFS is consistently less
than 3.0 V, and the O2S is consistently more than 0.55 V.
Lean/Rich: During A/F CONTROL, the output voltage of
the HO2 sensor alternates correctly.
B
CHECK AND REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO
SENSOR
C
CHECK AND REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR, AND CHECK AND REPAIR
EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
A
3
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAK
OK:
No gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST GAS
LEAKAGE POINT
OK
REPLACE FRONT AND REAR THREE-WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER IN BANK A WHERE
MALFUNCTION IS DETECTED
ES–242
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P043E
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detection
Reference Orifice Low Flow
DTC
P043F
Evaporative Emission System Reference Orifice High Flow
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
Monitoring Items
ES
P043E
P043F
Reference orifice
clogged
Reference orifice
high-flow
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure through
reference orifice, and
EVAP system
pressure measured
to determine leak
criterion. 0.02 inch
leak criterion
measured at start
and at end of leak
check.
If system pressure
lower than -4.85 kPa
(-36.38 mmHg)*,
ECM determines that
reference orifice has
clogging malfunction.
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure through
reference orifice, and
EVAP system
pressure measured
to determine leak
criterion. 0.02 inch
leak criterion
measured at start
and at end of leak
check.
If system pressure
higher than -1.06 kPa
(-7.95 mmHg)*, ECM
determines that
reference orifice has
high-flow
malfunction.
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
Canister pump
module
Connector/wire
harness
(Canister pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Leakage from
EVAP system
While ignition switch
OFF
2 trip
Canister pump
module
Connector / Wire
harness
(Canister pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Leakage from
EVAP system
While ignition switch
OFF
2 trip
The threshold values vary according to the atmospheric pressure measured at EVAP monitor beginning.
The values described in the table above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg)
(absolute pressure).
HINT:
The reference orifice is located inside the canister pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system (See page ES-423).
ES–243
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned
OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after ignition switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
In order to determine leak
criterion, leak detection pump
creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operations
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES
ES–244
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation B, E:
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Criterion Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
OFF (vent)
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
ES
Reference Orifice (0.02 Inch)
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON (closed)
OFF
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
ON (closed)
Negative
Pressure
ON
ON
A112612E02
ES–245
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P043E: Reference orifice clogged
In operation B, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the reference
orifice. The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to
determine the 0.02 inch leak criterion. If the pressure is lower than -4.85 kPa (-36.38 mmHg)*, the
ECM interprets this as a clog malfunction in the reference orifice, and stops the EVAP system monitor.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Reference Orifice Clogged:
ON: Open
Purge VSV
ON
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Malfunction
Sequence
A
B
C
D
E
Time (Second)
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106056E06
ES
ES–246
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P043F: Reference orifice high-flow
In operation B, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the reference
orifice. The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to
determine the 0.02 inch leak criterion. If the pressure is higher than -1.06 kPa (-7.95 mmHg)*, the ECM
interprets this as a high-flow malfunction in the reference orifice, and stops the EVAP system monitor.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Reference Orifice High-flow Malfunction:
ON: Open
Purge VSV
ON
OFF: Closed
ES
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
ON
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Sequence
A
B
Time (Second)
10
60
C
Within 900
D
E
10
60
A106057E07
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 2 min. (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–247
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
"Saturated" indicates that the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) in 30 seconds.
One of following conditions met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement started
Higher than -1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Lower than -4.85 kPa (726 mmHg)
Reference pressure
-1.05 kPa (754 mmHg) or higher
Reference pressure
Not saturated within 60 seconds
Difference between first reference pressure and second reference
pressure
0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg) or higher
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information on Checking Monitor Status (See page ES-17).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP Inspection Procedure (See page ES-430).
ES
ES–248
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0441
Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect
Purge Flow
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
ES
P0441
P0441
P0441
Monitoring Items
Purge Vacuum
Switching Valve
(VSV) stuck open
Purge VSV stuck
closed
Purge flow
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in
EVAP system and
EVAP system
pressure measured.
0.02 inch leak
criterion measured at
start and at end of
leak check.
If stabilized pressure
higher than [second
0.02 inch leak
criterion x 0.2], ECM
determines that
purge VSV stuck
open.
After EVAP leak
check performed,
purge VSV turned
ON (open), and
atmospheric air
introduced into EVAP
system. 0.02 inch
leak criterion
measured at start
and at end of leak
check.
If pressure does not
return to near
atmospheric
pressure, ECM
determines that
purge VSV stuck
closed.
While engine running,
following conditions
are met:
• Negative
pressure not
created in EVAP
system when
purge VSV
turned ON (open)
• EVAP system
pressure change
less than 0.5 kPa
(3.75 mmHg)
when vent valve
turned ON
(closed)
• Atmospheric
pressure change
before and after
purge flow
monitor less than
0.1 kPa (0.75
mmHg)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(purge VSV ECM)
ECM
Canister pump
module
Leakage from
EVAP system
While ignition switch
OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(purge VSV ECM)
ECM
Canister pump
module
Leakage from
EVAP system
While ignition switch
OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(purge VSV ECM)
Leakage from
EVAP line
(purge VSV Intake manifold)
ECM
While engine running
2 trip
ES–249
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system (See page ES-425).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The 2 monitors, key-off and purge flow, are used to detect malfunctions relating to DTC P0441. The keyoff monitor is initiated by the ECM internal timer, known as the soak timer, 5 hours* after the ignition switch
is turned OFF. The purge flow monitor runs while the engine is running.
1. Key-off monitor
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative
pressure(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based
on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned
OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
A
B
C
D
E
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after ignition switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
ES
ES–250
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence
F
Operations
Final check
Descriptions
Duration
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation B, E:
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Criterion Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
OFF (vent)
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
ES
Canister Pump Module
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
Reference Orifice (0.02 Inch)
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON (closed)
OFF
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
ON (closed)
Negative
Pressure
ON
ON
A112612E02
ES–251
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a)Purge VSV stuck open
In operation C, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system.
The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor. If the
stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02 inch leak criterion x 0.2], the ECM interprets
this as the purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV) being stuck open. The ECM illuminates the MIL
and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Open:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
Malfunction
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
Second 0.02
inch Leak
Pressure
Standard x 0.2
OK
A
10 sec.
B
60 sec.
C
Within 15 minutes
D
10
sec.
E
60 sec.
A133722E01
ES
ES–252
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b)Purge VSV stuck closed
In operation D, the canister pressure sensor measures the EVAP system pressure. The pressure
measurement for the purge VSV monitor begins when the purge VSV is turned ON (open) after the
EVAP leak check. When the measured pressure indicates an increase of 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or
more, the purge VSV is functioning normally. If the pressure does not increase, the ECM interprets
this as the purge VSV being stuck closed. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip
detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Closed:
ES
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
Malfunction
A
10 sec.
B
60 sec.
C
Within 15 minutes
D
10
sec.
E
60 sec.
A133723E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–253
2. Purge flow monitor
EVAP Pressure During Purge Flow Monitor:
Open
Purge
VSV
ON
(Closed)
Vent Valve
Malfunction
0.1 kPa
EVAP
Pressure
OK
1st Monitor
0.5 kPa
OK
2nd Monitor
A071563E05
The purge flow monitor consists of the 2 step monitors. The 1st monitor is conducted every time and
the 2nd monitor is activated if necessary.
• The 1st monitor
While the engine is running and the purge VSV is ON (open), the ECM monitors the purge flow by
measuring the EVAP pressure change. If negative pressure is not created, the ECM begins the 2nd
monitor.
• The 2nd monitor
The vent valve is turned ON (closed) and the EVAP pressure is then measured. If the variation in the
pressure is less than 0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg), the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being stuck
closed, and illuminates the MIL and sets DTC P0441 (2 trip detection logic).
Atmospheric pressure check:
In order to ensure reliable malfunction detection, the variation between the atmospheric pressure, before
and after conduction of the purge flow monitor, is measured by the ECM.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0441: Purge VSV stuck open
P0441: Purge VSV stuck closed
P0441: Purge flow
Required sensors/Components
Purge VSV, Pump module
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Purge VSV stuck open and closed: Within 15 min. (varies with amount
of fuel in tank)
Purge flow: Within 10 min.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
ES
ES–254
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
ES
P0011 (VVT System 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT System 1 - Retard)
P0021 (VVT System 2 - Advance)
P0022 (VVT System 2 - Retard)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0308 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0351 - P0358 (Ignitor)
P0450 - P0453 (EVAP pressure sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Purge VSV stuck open and closed:
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
Purge flow
Engine
Running
ECT
4.4°C (40°F) or higher
IAT
4.4°C (40°F) or higher
EVAP pressure sensor
Not detected
EVAP canister purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP system check
Not operated by scan tool
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Purge duty cycle
8 % or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Purge VSV stuck open
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.2
Purge VSV stuck closed
EVAP pressure change after EVAP canister purge valve is open
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
Purge flow
Both of the following conditions are met
Condition 1 or 2
1. EVAP pressure change when purge flow is started
Less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg)
2. EVAP pressure change during purge flow when EVAP pressure
switching valve is ON (closed)
Less than 0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg)
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–255
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Inspection Procedure (See page ES-430).
ES
ES–256
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0450
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor Malfunction
DTC
P0451
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor Range / Performance
DTC
P0452
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch Low Input
DTC
P0453
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch High Input
ES
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
P0450
P0451
P0451
Monitoring Items
Pressure sensor
voltage abnormal
fluctuation
Pressure sensor
noising
Pressure sensor
stuck
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Sensor output
voltage rapidly
fluctuates beyond
upper and lower
malfunction
thresholds for 0.5
second.
Sensor output
voltage fluctuates
frequently in certain
time period.
Sensor output
voltage does vary in
certain time period.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0452
P0453
Pressure sensor
voltage low
Pressure sensor
voltage high
Sensor output
voltage is less than
0.45 V for 0.5
second.
Sensor output
voltage is more than
4.9 V for 0.5 second.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Detection Timing
•
•
•
•
Detection Logic
EVAP monitoring
(ignition OFF)
Ignition ON
1 trip
EVAP monitoring
(ignition OFF)
Engine running
2 trip
EVAP monitoring
(ignition OFF)
2 trip
•
•
Ignition ON
EVAP monitoring
(ignition OFF)
1 trip
•
•
Ignition ON
EVAP monitoring
(ignition OFF)
1 trip
HINT:
The Canister pressure sensor is built into the canister pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system (See page ES-425).
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–257
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
1. DTC P0450: Canister pressure sensor output abnormal fluctuation
Pressure Sensor Specification:
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60
110
kPa
kPa
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa
A133725E01
If the canister pressure sensor output rapidly fluctuates between less than 42.1 kPa and more than
123.8 kPa, the ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit malfunction in the canister pressure
sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
2. DTC P0451: Canister pressure sensor noise or stuck
If the canister pressure sensor voltage output fluctuates rapidly for 15 seconds, the ECM stops the
EVAP system monitor. The ECM interprets this as noise from the canister pressure sensor, and stops
the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
Alternatively, if the sensor voltage output does not change, the ECM interprets this as the sensor being
stuck, and stops the monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
(Both of the malfunctions are detected by 2 trip detection logic).
3. DTC P0452: Canister pressure sensor voltage low
If the canister pressure sensor output is below 42.1 kPa, the ECM interprets this as an open or short
circuit malfunction in the canister pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
4. DTC P0453: Canister pressure sensor voltage high
If the canister pressure sensor output is 123.8 kPa or more, the ECM interprets this as an open or short
circuit malfunction in the canister pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor.
The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0450: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor/switch
chattering
P0451: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor noise
P0451: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor stuck
P0452: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor/switch
low input
P0453: Evaporative emission control system pressure sensor/switch
high input
Required Sensors/Components
Canister pump module
ES
ES–258
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle: P0451 sensor stuck
Continuous: P0451 sensor noise, P0450, P0452 and P0453
Duration
0.5 seconds: P0450, P0452, P0453
15 seconds: P0451 sensor noise
120 seconds: P0451 sensor stuck
MIL Operation
Immediate: P0450, P0452, P0453
2 driving cycles: P0451
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Pressure sensor noise:
ES
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
IAT
4.4 to 40°C (40 to 104°F)
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
2. Engine condition
Running
Pressure sensor stuck:
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
IAT
4.4 to 40°C (40 to 104°F)
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
Pressure sensor chattering, low/high voltage:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Pressure sensor noise:
Frequency that EVAP pressure change is 0.3 kPa or more
10 times or more for 10 sec.
Pressure sensor stuck:
EVAP pressure change during reference pressure measurement
Less than 0.65 kPa (4.9 mmHg)
Pressure sensor chattering:
EVAP pressure
Less than 42.11 kPa (316 mmHg), or more than 123.761 kPa (928
mmHg)
Pressure sensor low pressure:
EVAP pressure
Less than 42.11 kPa (316 mmHg)
Pressure sensor high pressure:
EVAP pressure
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to EVAP System (See page ES-430).
More than 123.761 kPa (928 mmHg)
ES–259
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When a vehicle is brought into the workshop, leave it as it is. Do not change the vehicle
condition. For example, do not tighten the fuel cap.
• Do not disassemble the canister pump module.
• The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting
procedure.
1
CONFIRM DTC AND EVAP PRESSURE
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the values.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / EVAP / VAPOR PRESS.
(f) Read the EVAP pressure displayed on the intelligent
tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Test Result
P0451
-
P0452
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
Canister pressure sensor
A
•
Wire harness/connector
(ECM - canister pressure
sensor)
Canister pressure sensor
Short in ECM circuit
B
Wire harness/connector
(ECM - canister pressure
sensor)
Canister pressure sensor
Open in ECM circuit
C
Less than 45 kPa (338 mmHg)
•
•
•
P0453
More than 120 kPa (900 mmHg)
•
•
A
C
Proceed to
GO TO EVAP SYSTEM
Go to step 4
B
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
E8
PPMP
ECM Connector
G035619E13
(a) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
ES
ES–260
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
10 Ω or less
•
•
10 kΩ or more
•
Proceed to
Wire harness/connector (ECM canister pressure sensor)
Short in canister pressure sensor
circuit
A
Wire harness/connector (ECM canister pressure sensor)
Short in ECM circuit
B
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
B
Go to step 7
A
ES
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
L4
E8
PPMP
A137923E01
Result
Test Results
10 kΩ or more
10 Ω or less
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
•
Short in canister pressure sensor
circuit
A
•
Short in wire harness / connector
(ECM - canister pressure sensor)
B
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
A
Go to step 5
B
Go to step 6
ES–261
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage of the canister pump module
connector.
Standard voltage
L4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
L4-4 - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
L4-3 - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
(d) Measure the resistance of the canister pump module
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Canister Connector
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
L4-2 - Body ground
100 Ω or less
L4
Front View
A121713E02
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Voltage and resistance within standard
ranges
•
Open in canister pressure sensor
circuit
A
Voltage and resistance outside standard
ranges
•
Open in wire harness/connector (ECM
- canister pressure sensor)
B
(e) Connect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 6
A
5
REPLACE CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the canister assembly (See page EC-23).
NEXT
6
Go to step 8
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
HINT:
If the exhaust tailpipe has been removed, go to the next step
before reinstalling it.
NEXT
Go to step 8
ES
ES–262
7
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE ECM
(a) Replace the ECM (See page ES-510).
NEXT
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (AFTER REPAIR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Wait for at least 60 seconds.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the intelligent tester,
the repair has been successfully completed.
ES
NEXT
COMPLETED
ES–20
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECKING MONITOR STATUS
ES
The purpose of the monitor result (mode 06) is to allow
access to the results of on-board diagnostic monitoring tests
of specific components/systems that are not continuously
monitored. Examples are catalysts, evaporative emissions
(EVAP) and thermostats.
The monitor result allows the OBD II scan tool to display the
monitor status, test value, minimum test limit and maximum
test limit. These data are displayed after the vehicle has been
driven to run the monitor.
When the test value is not between the minimum and
maximum test limits, the ECM (PCM) interprets this as a
malfunction. If the test value is on the borderline of the test
limits, the component is likely to malfunction in the near
future.
Perform the following procedures to view the monitor status.
Although these procedures refer to the Lexus/Toyota
diagnostic tester, the monitor status can be checked using a
generic OBD II scan tool. Refer to your scan tool operator's
manual for specific procedural information.
1. PERFORM MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch and the tester ON.
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-35).
(d) Run the vehicle in accordance with the applicable
drive pattern described in READINESS MONITOR
DRIVE PATTERN (see page ES-20). Do not turn the
ignition switch OFF.
NOTE:
The test results will be lost if the ignition
switch is turned OFF.
2. ACCESS MONITOR RESULT
(a) Select the following items from the intelligent tester
menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD II,
MONITOR INFO and MONITOR RESULT. The
monitor status appears after the component name.
• INCMP: The component has not been monitored
yet.
• PASS: The component is functioning normally.
• FAIL: The component is malfunctioning.
(b) Confirm that the component is either PASS or FAIL.
(c) Select the component and press ENTER. The
accuracy test value appears if the monitor status is
either PASS or FAIL.
3. CHECK COMPONENT STATUS
(a) Compare the test value with the minimum test limit
(MIN LIMIT) and maximum test limit (MAX LIMIT).
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–21
(b) If the test value is between the minimum and
maximum test limits, the component is functioning
normally. If not, the component is malfunctioning.
The test value is usually not near the test limits. If
the test value is on the borderline of the test limits,
the component is likely to malfunction in the near
future.
HINT:
The monitor result might on rare occasions be
PASS even if the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
illuminated. This indicates the system malfunctioned
on a previous driving cycle. This might be caused by
an intermittent problem.
4. MONITOR RESULT INFORMATION
If you use a generic scan tool, multiply the test value by
the scaling value listed below.
A/F Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1) HO2S Bank 1 Sensor 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$01
$8E
Multiply by 0.001
V
A/F sensor deterioration level
$01
$91
Multiply by 0.004
mA
A/F sensor current
HO2 Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$02
$07
Multiply by 0.001
V
Minimum sensor voltage
$02
$08
Multiply by 0.001
V
Maximum sensor voltage
$02
$8F
Multiply by 0.0003
g
Maximum oxygen storage capacity
A/F Sensor Bank 2 HO2S Bank 2 Sensor 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$05
$8E
Multiply by 0.001
V
A/F sensor deterioration level
$05
$91
Multiply by 0.004
mA
A/F sensor current
HO2 Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$06
$07
Multiply by 0.001
V
Minimum sensor voltage
$06
$08
Multiply by 0.001
V
Maximum sensor voltage
$06
$8F
Multiply by 0.0003
g
Maximum oxygen storage capacity
Catalyst - Bank 1
Monitor ID
$21
Test ID
$A9
Scaling
Multiply by 0.0003
Unit
No dimension
Description
Oxygen storage capacity of catalyst bank 1
Catalyst - Bank 2
Monitor ID
$22
Test ID
$A9
Scaling
Multiply by 0.0003
Unit
No dimension
Description
Oxygen storage capacity of catalyst bank 2
EVAP
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$3D
$C9
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for small leak (P0456)
$3D
$CA
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for gross leak (P0455)
$3D
$CB
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for leak detection pump stuck OFF (P2401)
$3D
$CD
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for leak detection pump stuck ON (P2402)
$3D
$CE
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for vent valve stuck OFF (P2420)
$3D
$CF
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for vent valve stuck ON (P2419)
$3D
$D0
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for reference orifice low flow (P043E)
ES
ES–22
Monitor ID
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$3D
$D1
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for reference orifice high flow (P043F)
$3D
$D4
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge VSV stuck closed (P0441)
$3D
$D5
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge VSV stuck open (P0441)
$3D
$D7
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge flow insufficient (P0441)
Rear Oxygen Sensor Heater
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$42
$91
Multiply by 0.001
Ohm
Oxygen sensor heater resistance bank 1 sensor 2
$46
$91
Multiply by 0.001
Ohm
Oxygen sensor heater resistance bank 2 sensor 2
Secondary Air Injection (AIR)
Monitor ID
ES
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$71
$E1
Multiply by 0.01
g/sec.
Test value for AIR insufficient
$71
$E2
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR pump ON stuck
$71
$E3
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR pump OFF stuck
$71
$E4
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR valve(s) ON stuck
$71
$E5
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR valve(s) OFF stuck
$71
$E6
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR electrical valve
$71
$E7
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR VSV bank 1
$71
$E8
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR VSV bank 2
$71
$E9
Multiply by 0.01
kPa
Test value for AIR VSVs bank 1 and bank 2
Misfire
Monitor ID
$A1
Test ID
$0B
Scaling
Multiply by 1
Unit
Time
Description
Total EWMA misfire count of all cylinders in last ten driving
cycles
EWMA: Exponential Weighted Moving Average
•
$A1
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A2
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
•
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 1 in last ten driving cycles
•
$A2
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A3
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
•
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A4
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
•
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A5
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
•
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A6
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
•
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A7
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 4
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 4 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 5 in last ten driving cycles
•
$A6
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 3
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 3 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 4 in last ten driving cycles
•
$A5
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 2
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 2 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 3 in last ten driving cycles
•
$A4
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 1
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 1 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 2 in last ten driving cycles
•
$A3
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of all
cylinders in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of all cylinders in
current driving cycle is displayed.
•
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 5
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 5 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 6 in last ten driving cycles
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
•
$A7
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A8
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
$A8
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
$A9
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
•
•
Multiply by 1
Time
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 7
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 7 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 8 in last ten driving cycles
•
$0C
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 6
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 6 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
Total EWMA misfire count of cylinder 7 in last ten driving cycles
•
$A9
ES–23
•
When ignition switch is ON, total misfire count of cylinder 8
in last driving cycle is displayed.
While engine is running, total misfire count of cylinder 8 in
current driving cycle is displayed.
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–263
DTC
P0455
Evaporative Emission Control System Leak
Detected (Gross Leak)
DTC
P0456
Evaporative Emission Control System Leak
Detected (Very Small Leak)
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
P0455
P0456
Monitoring Items
EVAP gross leak
EVAP small leak
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in
EVAP system and
EVAP system
pressure measured.
0.02 inch leak
criterion measured at
start and at end of
leak check.
If stabilized pressure
higher than [second
0.02 inch leak
criterion x 0.2], ECM
determines that
EVAP system has
large leakage.
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in
EVAP system and
EVAP system
pressure measured.
0.02 inch leak
criterion measured at
start and at end of
leak check.
If stabilized pressure
higher than second
0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM
determines that
EVAP system has
small leakage.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
Fuel cap (loose)
Leakage from
EVAP line
(canister - fuel
tank)
Leakage from
EVAP line (purge
VSV - canister)
Canister pump
module
Leakage from
fuel tank
Leakage from
canister
Same as above
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
ES
While ignition switch
OFF
2 trip
While ignition switch
OFF
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system (See page ES-425).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP system (See page ES-430).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
ES–264
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned
OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after ignition switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
Operations
ES
B
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–265
Operation B, E:
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Criterion Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
OFF (vent)
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
Reference Orifice (0.02 Inch)
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
ES
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON (closed)
OFF
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
ON (closed)
Negative
Pressure
ON
ON
A112612E02
1. P0455: EVAP gross leak
In operation C, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and
the EVAP system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02
inch leak criterion x 0.2] (near atmospheric pressure), the ECM determines that the EVAP system has
a large leakage, illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
ES–266
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P0456: EVAP very small leak
In operation C, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and
the EVAP system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than the second
0.02 inch leak criterion, the ECM determines that the EVAP system has a small leakage, illuminates
the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when EVAP System Leaks:
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
ES
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
P0455
Positive
Negative
P0456
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
OK
A
B
C
D
E
10
60
Within 900
10
60
Sequence
Time (Second)
A106061E03
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0455: Gross leak detected
P0456: Very small leak (0.020 inch hole) detected
Required sensors/Components
Purge VSV, Pump module
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 min. (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–267
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Small leak (0.020 inch) malfunction detection:
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Between reference pressure and reference pressure x 0.2
Gross leak detection:
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.2
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
ES
ES–268
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
DTC
P0503
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A" Intermittent / Erratic /
High
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles, which are equipped with ABS (Anti-Lock Brake System), detect the vehicle speed using the skid
control ECU and wheel speed sensor. The wheel speed sensor monitors the wheel rotation speed and
sends a signal to the skid control ECU. The skid control ECU converts the wheel speed signal into a 4pulse signal and transmits it to the ECM via the combination meter. The ECM determines the vehicle
speed based on the frequency of the pulse signal.
ES
4-Pulse
From Wheel
Speed Sensor
4-Pulse
ECM
Skid Control
ECU
Combination Meter
A079413E03
DTC No.
P0500
P0503
DTC Detection Condition
The ECM detects following conditions simultaneously
for 1 second (1 trip detection logic):
• No SPD (speed sensor) signal while ECM detects
NC (transmission counter gear) signal
• Park / Neutral position switch is OFF (When shift
lever is in other than P and N positions)
• Transfer lever is in other than N position (4WD)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Skid control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM assumes that the vehicle is driven when the park/neutral position switch is OFF and it has been
over 4 seconds since the actual vehicle speed was 6 mph (9 km/h) or more.
If there is no signal from the vehicle speed sensor when these conditions are satisfied, the ECM
concludes that there is a fault in the vehicle speed sensor. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0500: Vehicle speed sensor "A" pulse input error
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Vehicle speed sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Park / Neutral position switch, Engine coolant temperature sensor, Combination
meter
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
ES–269
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
Vehicle speed
9 km/h (6 mph) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor signal
No pulse input
WIRING DIAGRAM
11
1K
1
1G
V-R
Center J/B
Driver Side J/B
Combination Meter
5
C9
B
3D
B
3D
G
J30
V-R
V-R
J/C
ES
V-R
ECM
G
J29
V-R
8
SPD
E7
A133728E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch to ON and turn the tester ON.
Start the engine.
Enter the following menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / VEHICLE SPD.
(e) Read the vehicle speed on the intelligent tester.
Result
Vehicle speed
Proceed to
Vehicle speed is same as actual speed
A
ES–270
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Vehicle speed
Proceed to
Vehicle speed remains 0 mph (0 km/h)
B
Vehicle speed is lower than actual speed
B
CHECK SPEEDOMETER CIRCUIT
(COMBINATION METER)
A
2
INSPECT ECM (SPD VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ES
Wire Harness Side
E6
E7
E1
SPD
NG
4.5 to
5.5V
Turn Wheel
A115707E02
OK
REPLACE ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SPD (E7-8) - E1 (E6-1)
Generated intermittently
HINT:
The output voltage should fluctuate up and down
similarly to the diagram when the wheel is turned slowly.
ECM Connector
0V
Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
Jack up the vehicle.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E6 and E7 ECM connectors as the wheel is turned
slowly.
Standard
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR BETWEEN COMBINATION
METER AND ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–485
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
ES
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119828E01
ES–486
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES
TIMING BELT COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 3 LH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
OIL COOLER PIPE
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119829E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–487
ES
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119819E01
ES–271
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0504
Brake Switch "A" / "B" Correlation
DESCRIPTION
In addition to turning on the stop lights, the stop light switch signals are used for a variety of engine,
transmission and suspension functions. The stop light switch is designed with 2 complementary signal
outputs, STP and ST1-. The ECM analyzes these signal outputs to detect malfunctions in the stop light
switch.
HINT:
Normal condition is as shown in the table below.
Signal
Brake Pedal Released
In Transition
Brake Pedal Depressed
STP
OFF
ON
ON
ST1-
ON
ON
OFF
DTC No.
P0504
DTC Detection Condition
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for 0.5 seconds or
more:
(a) Ignition switch ON
(b) Brake pedal released
(c) STP signal is OFF when the ST1- signal is OFF
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
STOP fuse
Stop light switch assembly
ECM
ES
ES–272
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
11
IC3
R-L
16
E8 ST1-
R-L
G-W
From IGN Fuse
From IG1 Fuse
T14
Towing Converter Relay
C B-O
J4
J/C
C
B-O
3
2
ES
G-W
Y-R
Y-R
S12
Stop Light
SW
4
D
G-Y
2
2
1
2
E
B
G-Y
16 1F
G-Y
2
5
STOP
LPCTRL
Relay
STIN
8
G-Y
D
2
2
Driver
Side J/B
J1
J/C
Y-R
B
J4
J/C
B
Engine
Room
STOP
R/B
24 1E
E
1
R-L
G-B
C J41
C J41
1
J/C
4
G-Y
3
B J40
G-Y
STOP
2
ALT
1
2
2
B J40
G-Y
STOP
1
1
Engine Room R/B
2
LG
15 IC3
B
Center
J/B
E 3C
2
Engine
Room
R/B
G-B
16 S28
STPO
Skid Control ECU with
Actuator
E
E
6
R14
Rear Combination
Light LH
J4
J/C
W-B
A J40
G-Y
H J31
B
R15
Rear
Combination
Light RH
W-B
A J40
J/C
E 3C
2
6
G-B
A J41
J/C
E J32
G-Y
Battery
W-B
BL
15
E8 STP
A133729E02
ES–273
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK OPERATION OF STOP LIGHT
(a) Check if the stop lights turn on and off normally when the
brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK :
Stop light turns ON when brake pedal is
depressed.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
2
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the stop light switch (See page LI-71).
NG
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
OK
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STP SIGNAL AND ST1- VOLTAGE)
Brake Pedal
Depressed
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / STOP LIGHT SW.
(d) Confirm the stop light switch status when the brake pedal
is depressed and released.
OK
Brake Pedal
Released
Brake Pedal Condition
ECM Connector
E6
E1 (-)
Specified Condition
Depressed
STP Signal ON
Released
STP Signal OFF
(e) Measure the voltage of the ECM when the brake pedal is
depressed and released.
Standard voltage
E8
ST1- (+)
A112419E05
Tester Connection
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
Depressed
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
Released
7.5 to 14 V
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–274
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (STOP LIGHT SWITCH - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the S12 stop light switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
Stop Light Switch connector
Tester Connection
S12
Stop light switch (S12-1) - STP (E815)
Stop light switch (S12-4) - ST1- (E816)
Front View
ES
Stop light switch (S12-1) or STP (E815) - Body ground
Stop light switch (S12-4) or ST1- (E816) - Body ground
E8
OK
REPLACE ECM
ST1STP
A138065E01
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the stop light switch connector.
NG
ECM Connector
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–275
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The idle speed is controlled by the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS). The ETCS is comprised of:
1) one valve type throttle body; 2) the throttle actuator, which operates the throttle valve; 3) the throttle
position sensor, which detects the opening angle of the throttle valve; 4) the accelerator pedal position
sensor, which detects the accelerator pedal position; and 5) the ECM, which controls the ETCS. Based on
the target idle speed, the ECM controls the throttle actuator to provide the proper throttle valve opening
angle.
DTC No.
P0505
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from target speed (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
ETCS
Air induction system
Ventilation hose connection
ECM
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM detects idle speed and idle air flow amount for Idle Speed Control (ISC). The ECM concludes
that the ISC is malfunctioning if: 1) the learned value of the ISC remains at the maximum or minimum 5
times or more during a drive cycle, and 2) while driving at 6 mph (10 km/h) or more, the actual idle rpm
varies from the target rpm by between 100 to 150 rpm 5 times or more during a drive cycle.
Example:
If the actual idle rpm varies from the target idle rpm by more than 100 rpm* 5 times during a drive cycle,
the ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
HINT:
*: rpm threshold varies with engine load.
Example
Idle Speed
Idle Speed Learned Valve
Maximum
Large
Target RPM
0
Minimum
Actual Idle RPM
Small
Time
Time
A121611E01
ES–276
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0505: Idle air control malfunction
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Crankshaft position sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
ECT sensor, Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 minutes
MIL Operation
2 drive cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Engine
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following condition is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Frequency that both of following conditions (a) and (b) are met
5 times or more
(a) Engine RPM - Target engine RPM (A/C OFF and NSW OFF)
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 150 rpm
(b) Vehicle condition
Stop after vehicle was driven at 6 mph (10 km/h) or more
2. Frequency that both of following conditions (a) and (b) are met
Once
(a) Engine RPM - Target engine RPM
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 150 rpm
(b) IAC flow rate learning value
2.48 L/sec or less, or 11 L/sec or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• The detection of DTC P0505 may also be caused by: 1) the floor carpet overlapping onto the
accelerator pedal, causing the accelerator pedal to be slightly depressed (throttle position to be slightly
open); or 2) the accelerator pedal not being fully released.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0505)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0505 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0505
A
P0505 and other DTCs
B
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–277
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P0505 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF VENTILATION HOSE
OK:
Ventilation hose is connected correctly and is not
damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VENTILATION HOSE
OK
3
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Check the throttle valve condition.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
ES
ES–278
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P050A
Cold Start Idle Air Control System Performance
DTC
P050B
Cold Start Ignition Timing Performance
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) controls the engine idling speed. The ETCS operates the
throttle actuator to open and close the throttle valve, and adjusts the intake air amount to achieve the
target idling speed.
In addition, the ECM retards the ignition timing and the ETCS increases the intake air amount to quickly
increase the catalyst temperature at cold start.
DTC No.
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P050A
Accumulated intake air amount during 10 seconds of idling
after cold start is less than threshold (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
P050B
Ignition timing retard value insufficient for 5 seconds or
more during 10 seconds of P050A monitoring duration at
cold start (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle body assembly
Mass air flow meter
Air induction system
Ventilation hose connections
ECM
Throttle body assembly
Mass air flow meter
Air induction system
Ventilation hose connections
VVT system
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Timing
Accumulated Intake Air Value
P050B Detected
Pass Detected
(g)
Advanced
5 or more
P050A Detected
Threshold
Threshold
Pass Detected
0
Retarded
10
3
(Second)
(Second)
Time
Time
Engine Start
10
3
Engine Start
A112588E01
The ECM monitors the intake air amount during idling and the ignition timing.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–279
When the engine coolant temperature is between -10°C and 50°C (14°F and 122°F), the ECM calculates
the idling intake air amount for 10 seconds, beginning 3 seconds after the engine starts.
When the accumulated value is below the threshold, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the Idle
Speed Control (ISC) system at cold start.
The ECM also monitors the ignition timing at cold start, and judges it to be incorrect when it is advanced to
the same value for a warm engine for 5 seconds or more of the 10 second monitoring period.
Example:
P050A is detected when all conditions below are met.
1. The engine coolant temperature is between -10°C and 50°C (14°F and 122°F) when the engine starts.
2. The engine idles for 13 seconds after engine start.
3. The accumulated intake air amount is below the threshold.
The ECM sets the DTC and illuminates the MIL 3 seconds after the engine is next started (2 trip
detection logic).
NOTICE:
When the negative battery terminal is disconnected during inspection or repairs, the ISC
learning values are cleared. The ISC learning must be performed by warming up the engine and
idling for 5 minutes with the engine coolant temperature at 75°C (167°F) or more because DTCs
cannot be detected with the ISC learning values cleared.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P050A: Idle speed control problem at cold
P050B: Idle ignition timing problem at cold
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Mass air flow meter
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor, Throttle position sensor,
Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
P050A:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Time after engine start
3 seconds or more
Starter
OFF
ECT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or more
ECT
-10°C to 50°C (14°F to 122°F)
Engine idling time
3 seconds or more
Fuel-cut
OFF
Vehicle speed
Less than 1.86 mph (3 km/h)
Time after shift position changed
1 second or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or more
P050B:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Time after engine start
3 seconds or more
Starter
OFF
ECT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or more
ECT
-10 to 50°C (14 to 122°F)
Engine idling time
3 seconds or more
ES
ES–280
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fuel-cut
OFF
Vehicle speed
Less than 1.86 mph (3 km/h)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P050A:
Accumulated air flow amount
Varies with ECT (Example: Less than 102 g)
P050B:
Accumulated timing when ignition timing retard is cut off
5 seconds or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P050A)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the tester ON.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P050A and/or P050B
A
P050A and/or P050B and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P050A and P050B are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (FUEL TRIM)
HINT:
Calculate the total fuel trim values to check the characteristic
deviation of the mass air flow meter.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / SHORT
FT #1 and LONG FT #1.
(e) Read the values displayed on the tester.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(f)
ES–281
Add together the SHORT FT #1 and LONG FT #1 values
to obtain the total FUEL TRIM.
OK:
Total of the SHORT FT #1 and LONG FT #1 values
is between -20% and 20%.
OK
Go to step 12
NG
3
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
Warm up the engine.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1 or
VVT CTRL B2.
(e) Check the engine speed while operating the Oil Control
Valve (OCV) using the tester.
OK
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV ON
Engine idles roughly or stalls (soon after OCV switched from OFF
to ON)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
4
CHECK VENTILATION HOSE CONNECTIONS
OK:
Ventilation hose is connected correctly and is not
damaged.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
5
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
OK
Go to step 10
ES
ES–282
6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT
(a) Visually check that the air cleaner filter element is not
excessively contaminated with dirt or oil.
OK:
Air cleaner filter element is not excessively
contaminated with dirt or oil.
NG
Go to step 11
OK
ES
7
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
NEXT
8
CHECK AND REPAIR VVT SYSTEM
NEXT
9
Go to step 15
REPLACE AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT
NEXT
12
Go to step 15
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
NEXT
11
Go to step 15
REPAIR OR REPLACE VENTILATION HOSE
NEXT
10
Go to step 15
Go to step 15
CHECK THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Check for deposits around the throttle valve and throttle
valve condition.
OK:
No deposits around the throttle valve and throttle
valve moves smoothly
NG
OK
Go to step 14
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
13
REPLACE ECM
NEXT
14
Go to step 15
CLEAN OR REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY
NEXT
15
ES–283
Go to step 15
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P050A AND/OR P050B)
NOTICE:
In this operation, the engine must be cold (the same level
as the engine coolant temperature recorded in the freeze
frame data).
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Clear DTCs (see page ES-35).
(e) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the tester (see page ES-36).
(f) Start the engine and idle it for a minute.
OK:
Stable fast idling.
(g) Read DTCs.
OK:
No DTC output.
NEXT
END
ES
ES–284
DTC
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0560
System Voltage
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery supplies electricity to the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF. This electricity allows the
ECM to store data such as DTC history, freeze frame data, fuel trim values, and other data. If the battery
voltage falls below a minimum level, the memory is cleared and the ECM will conclude that there is a fault
in the power supply circuit. At the next engine start, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
DTC No.
P0560
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open in ECM back-up power source circuit
Open in back-up power source circuit
EFI fuse
ECM
HINT:
If DTC P0560 appears, the ECM does not store another DTC.
ES
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560: ECM system voltage
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate (MIL will be illuminated after next engine start)
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Stand-by RAM
Initialized
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECM power source
Less than 3.5 V
ES–285
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room R/B
EFI
B
2
1
2
2
L
12
IC4
3
BATT
E8
L
ES
Battery
A074726E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (BATTERY VOLTAGE)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / BATTERY VOLTAGE.
Result
Battery voltage
Proceed to
Battery voltage is 0 V
A
Battery voltage is except 0 V
B
B
A
Go to step 5
ES–286
2
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT FUSE (EFI NO. 1)
(a) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Engine
Room R/B:
EFI Fuse
NG
REPLACE FUSE
A072881E01
ES
OK
3
CHECK ECM (BATT VOLTAGE)
Wire Harness Side
E6
E8
OK
ECM Connector
E1
NG
(a) Measure the voltage between terminals of the E6 and E8
ECM connector.
Standard voltage
BATT
A115711E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
BATT (E8-3) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–287
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - EFI NO. 1 FUSE)
Engine Room R/B:
EFI Fuse
(a) Check the harness and the connector between the EFI
fuse and ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine room R/B (EFI fuse terminal 2) - BATT (E83)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
E8
ECM Connector
BATT
A138068E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine room R/B (EFI fuse terminal 2) or BATT
(E8-3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connector between the EFI
fuse and battery.
(1) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room R/B.
(2) Disconnect the negative battery cable.
(3) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive battery cable - Engine room R/B (EFI fuse
terminal 1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive battery cable or Engine room R/B (EFI
fuse terminal 1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
(5) Reconnect the negative battery cable.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check that the battery is not depleted.
OK:
Battery voltage is 11 V or more.
NG
REPLACE BATTERY
ES
ES–288
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0604
ES–289
Random Access Memory (RAM)
DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal memory status. This self-check ensures that the ECM is
functioning properly. This is diagnosed by internal "mirroring" of the main CPU and sub CPU to detect the
Random Access Memory (RAM) errors. If outputs from these CPUs are different and deviate from the
standards, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC immediately.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0604
ECM RAM errors
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required sensors / components (main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (sub)
None
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
16 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
None
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Main CPU and sub CPU mirroring
Fail
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery terminal
and wait for 1 minute.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(f) Check DTC.
OK:
P0604 is not present.
NG
OK
INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–290
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0606
ECM / PCM Processor
DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal processors (CPUs), A/F sensor transistors and heated oxygen
sensor (HO2S) transistors. This self-check ensures that the ECM is functioning properly. This is
diagnosed by internal "mirroring" of the main and sub CPUs to detect processor errors. If outputs from the
processors deviate from the standards, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC immediately.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0606
•
•
•
•
•
•
ECM CPUs malfunction
A/F sensor transistors malfunction
HO2S transistors malfunction
Exhaust gas leak
HO2S
ECM
NOTICE:
First check for an exhaust gas leak around the HO2S if P0606 is present. An exhaust gas leak
generates noise in the HO2S output. The ECM may interpret this as an HO2S transistor
malfunction and set P0606.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required sensors / components (main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (sub)
APP sensor, TP sensor, Brake switch, Cruise control, A/F sensor,
HO2S
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
60 seconds
MIL operation
immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Engine
Running
Estimated A/F sensor temperature
450 - 800°C (842 - 1,472°F)
Estimated HO2S temperature
450 - 800°C (842 - 1,472°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference of main APP and sub APP
0.3 V or more
Difference of main TP and sub TP
0.3 V or more
Difference of main brake switch signal and sub brake switch signal
Different
A/F sensor transistors
Fail
HO2S transistors
Fail
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Check for an exhaust gas leak around the HO2S.
OK:
No leak from the HO2S.
NG
REPAIR LEAK
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–291
OK
2
CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
Fuel-Trim and Rear HO2S Voltage Cross-reference
Fuel-Trim
25%
-12.5%
ES
HO2S Voltage
0.8 V
0.2 V
A144391E01
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Select the tester menus: ENHANCED OBDII, ACTIVE
TEST AND A/F CONTROL.
(d) Check the O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2) values when the A/F
CONTROL is -12.5% (Lean fuel-trim).
(e) Check the O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2) values when the A/F
CONTROL is 25% (Rich fuel-trim).
Standard
A/F CONTROL
O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2)
-12.5%
Less than 0.2 V
25%
More than 0.8 V
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
3
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery terminal
and wait for 1 minute.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal.
(e) Start the engine.
ES–292
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Monitor Drive Pattern for P0606
Engine Coolant Temperature: 75°C (167°F) or more
km/h (mph)
5 Minutes
80 (50)
60 (35)
Time
0
ES
A144392E01
(f)
Perform the drive pattern.
(1) Warm up the engine.
(2) Accelerate the vehicle until 80 km/h (50 mph) and
stop the vehicle.
(3) Drive the vehicle by 60 to 80 km/h (35 to 50 mph) for
5 minutes or more.
(g) Check DTC.
OK:
P0606 is not present.
NG
OK
INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0607
ES–293
Control Module Performance
DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its main and sub CPUs. This self-check ensures that the ECM is
functioning properly. If outputs from the CPUs are different and deviate from the standards, the ECM will
illuminate the MIL and set a DTC immediately.
The ECM also monitors the cruise control cancel circuit. If this circuit malfunctions, the ECM will set a
DTC immediately (MIL is not illuminated).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0607
•
•
•
ECM
ECM main CPU error
ECM sub CPU error
Cruise control cancel circuit malfunction
ES
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required sensors / components (main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (sub)
-
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
16 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
CPU reset
Occurred
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
When either condition below is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. When all conditions below are met:
-
- CPU reset
1 time or more
- Learned TP - Learned APP
0.4 V or more
- Electronic throttle actuator
OFF
2. CPU reset
2 times or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery terminal
and wait for 1 minute.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(f) Check DTC.
OK:
P0607 is not present.
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES–294
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–295
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0617
Starter Relay Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
While the engine is being cranked, the battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM.
If the vehicle is being driven and the ECM detects the starter control signal (STA), the ECM concludes that
the starter control circuit is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
DTC No.
P0617
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
The following conditions are met for 20 seconds:
• Vehicle speed is greater than 12 mph (20 km/h)
• Engine RPM is greater than 1,000 rpm
• ECM detects STA
•
•
•
•
Starter relay circuit
Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch
Ignition switch
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0617: Starter signal error
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
STARTER relay, PNP switch, Ignition switch
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Vehicle speed sensor, Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
20 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
12.4 mph (20 km/h) or more
Engine rpm
1,000 rpm or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Starter signal
ON
ES–296
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
R
B-Y
8
E5 STAR /
NSW
P
2
2
5
2
2
1
AM2
ES
N
P
B-Y
1
3
2
Engine
Room R/B
5
2
2
B-Y
2
A
Y-G
J28
J/C
W-B
B
B-R
1
S2
Battery
11 IM1
G
EB
11
E6 STA
B-Y
1
S3
Starter
B-Y
B-Y
B
J3
Y-G J/C
A
A
2 IC4
6 EA1
B
P1
Park / Neutral
Position Switch
4
STA
Relay
G
B-Y
J35
J/C
A133731E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• This DTC chart is on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine is not cranked,
proceed to the problem symptoms table (See page ES-26).
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STARTER SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / STARTER SIG.
ES–297
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Confirm the starter signal status when the ignition switch
is operated.
OK
Ignition Switch Position
STARTER SIG
ON
OFF
Start
ON
OK
Go to step 5
NG
2
INSPECT PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Move the shift lever to the P or N position.
(b) Disconnect the P1 Park / Neutral Position (PNP) switch
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the PNP switch.
Standard resistance
Component Side
P1
Shift Position
Tester Connection
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Specified Condition
P
2 - 6, 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
R
1-2
Below 1 Ω
N
2 - 9, 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
D, 4
2-7
Below 1 Ω
3
2-4
Below 1 Ω
2, L
2-8
Below 1 Ω
A093221E12
(d) Reconnect the park / neutral position switch connector.
NG
REPLACE PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH (GO TO STEP 5 AFTER THE
REPLACEMENT)
OK
3
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Component Side: Ignition Switch
I18
IG1
ST2
ACC
4
8
AM1
3
7
AM2
Front View
2
6
ST1
1
5
(a) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the connector terminals
shown in the chart below.
Standard resistance
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
All Terminals
10 kΩ or higher
ACC
2-3
Below 1 Ω
ON
2-3, 2-4, 6-7
Below 1 Ω
START
1-2, 2-4, 6-7, 6-8
Below 1 Ω
IG2
A087913E10
(c) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(GO TO STEP 5 AFTER REPLACEMENT)
ES
ES–298
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STARTER SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) On the intelligent tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL /
STARTER SIG.
(d) Read the values.
OK
ES
NG
Ignition Switch Position
STARTER SIG
ON
OFF
START
ON
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P0617)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs.
Drive the vehicle more than 25 mph (40 km/h) for 20
seconds or more.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0617
A
No DTC output
B
B
A
REPLACE ECM
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–299
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0630
VIN not Programmed or Mismatch - ECM / PCM
DESCRIPTION
DTC P0630 is set if the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is not stored in the ECM or the input VIN is not
accurate. Input the VIN with the intelligent tester.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
P0630
Trouble Area
VIN not stored in ECM
Input VIN in ECM not accurate
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0630: VIN not programmed
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.325 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
ES
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
None
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
VIN code
Not programmed
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VIN code
Programmed
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ CURRENT DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0630
A
P0630 and other DTCs
B
If any DTCs other than P0630 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
ES–300
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NOTICE:
If P0630 is set, the VIN must be input to the ECM
using the intelligent tester. However, all DTCs are
cleared automatically by the tester when inputting
the VIN. If DTCs other than P0630 are set, check
them first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
INPUT VIN WITH INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Input VIN with the intelligent tester (See page ES-12).
ES
NEXT
END
ES–24
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE
PATTERN
1.
ES
PURPOSE OF READINESS TESTS
• The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) system is
designed to monitor the performance of emissionrelated components, and indicate any detected
abnormalities with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC).
Since various components need to be monitored
during different driving conditions, the OBD II system
is designed to run separate monitoring programs
called Readiness Monitors.
• The intelligent tester's software must be version 9.0 or
newer to view the Readiness Monitor Status. To view
the status, Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR INFO / MONITOR
STATUS.
• When the Readiness Monitor status reads COMPL
(complete), the necessary conditions have been met
for running the performance tests for that Readiness
Monitor.
• A generic OBD II scan tool can also be used to view
the Readiness Monitor status.
HINT:
Many state Inspection and Maintenance (I/M) programs
require a vehicle's Readiness Monitor status to show
COMPL before beginning emissions tests.
The Readiness Monitor will be reset to INCMPL
(incomplete) if:
• The ECM has lost battery power or blown a fuse.
• DTCs have been cleared.
• The conditions for running the Readiness Monitor
have not been met.
If the readiness monitor status shows INCMPL, follow
the appropriate readiness monitor drive pattern to
change the status to COMPL.
CAUTION:
Strictly observe posted speed limits, traffic laws, and
road conditions when performing these drive
patterns.
NOTICE:
The following drive patterns are the fastest method
of completing all the requirements necessary for
making the readiness monitor status read
"complete". If forced to momentarily stop a drive
pattern due to traffic or other factors, the drive
pattern can be resumed. Upon completion of the
drive pattern, in most cases, the readiness monitor
status will change to "complete". Sudden changes in
vehicle load and speed, such as driving up and
down hills and/or sudden acceleration, hinder
readiness monitor completion.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–25
Contents:
TITLE
STEP(s)
CATALYST MONITOR
Procedure "A"
EVAP MONITOR
Procedure "B", "C"
AIR-FUEL RATIO (A/F) AND OXYGEN SENSOR (O2S) MONITOR
Procedure "D"
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER MONITOR
Procedure "E"
2.
CATALYST MONITOR (ACTIVE AIR FUEL RATIO
CONTROL TYPE) (Procedure "A")
Vehicle Speed
Between
[B]
ES
40 and 70 mph
(64 and 113 km/h)
Idling
[A]
Ignition Switch ON
Warm up
10 minutes
Time
(Note: Even when vehicle stops during pattern, test can be resumed.)
A115372E38
3.
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
– The MIL is OFF
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(4) Clear DTC (if set) (See page ES-35).
(5) Start the engine and warm it up [A].
(6) Drive vehicle at between 40 to 70 mph (64 and
113 km/h) for at least 10 minutes [B].
NOTICE:
This test will not be completed if the vehicle
is driven under absolutely constant speed,
such as with cruise control activated.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester.
(2) If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), extend the driving time.
EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR (KEY OFF TYPE)
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
ES–26
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
–
–
–
–
ES
4.
The fuel tank is less than 90% full.
The altitude is less than 8,000 ft (2,450 m).
The vehicle is stationary.
The engine coolant temperature is between 4.4
and 35°C (40 and 95°F).
– The intake air temperature is between 4.4 and
35°C (40 and 95°F).
– Vehicle was driven in an urban area (or on a freeway) for 10 minutes or more.
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 6
hours.
HINT:
Do not start the engine until checking Readiness
Monitor status. If the engine is started, the step
described above must be repeated.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Turn the tester or scan tool ON.
(4) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester or scan tool.
If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), restart the engine, make sure that
the preconditions have been met, and then
perform the Monitor Conditions again.
AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) AND HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR (HO2) MONITOR (ACTIVE AIR FUEL RATIO
CONTROL TYPE)
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
– 2 minutes or more have elapsed since the engine
was started.
– The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 75°C
(167°F) or higher.
– Air fuel ratio feedback control is performed.
– Fuel-cut control is performed for 8 seconds or
more (for the Rear HO2 Sensor Monitor).
(b) Drive Pattern for front A/F sensor and rear HO2
sensor
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Turn the tester ON.
(4) Clear DTCs (if set) (See page ES-35).
(5) Start the engine, and warm it up until the ECT
reaches 75°C (167°F) or higher [A].
(6) Drive the vehicle at 40 mph (64 km/h) or more
for at least 10 minutes [B].
(7) Change the transmission to 2nd gear [C].
(8) Accelerate the vehicle to 30 mph (48 km/h) or
more by depressing the accelerator pedal for at
least 10 seconds [D].
ES–27
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(9) Soon after performing the step above, release
the accelerator pedal for at least 4 seconds
without depressing the brake pedal, in order to
execute fuel-cut control [E].
(10)Allow the vehicle to decelerate until the vehicle
speed declines to less than 6 mph (10 km/h) [F].
(11)Repeat steps from [D] through [F] above at least
3 times in one driving cycle [G].
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester.
(2) If the status does not switch to COMPL
(complete), make sure that the preconditions
have been met, and then perform steps from [A]
through [G] in "Drive Pattern" procedures above.
Monitor Drive Pattern
Accelerator Pedal
Released (Fuel-cut)
ETC: 75°C (167°F) or higher
Vehicle Speed
Accelerator Pedal
Depressed
[B]
40 to 75 mph
(64 to 120 km/h)
30 mph (48 km/h)
or more
[A]
At least 3 times
[D]
[E]
[F]
6 mph
(10 km/h)
[C]
Idling
Time
Warming up
10 minutes
or more
10 seconds 4 seconds
or more
or more
A115374E05
ES
ES–28
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5.
AIR FUEL RATIO (A/F) AND HEATED OXYGEN (HO2)
SENSOR HEATER MONITOR (FRONT A/F AND REAR
HO2 SENSOR TYPE)
25 mph (40 km/h)
ES
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Over 500 seconds
Over 2 minutes
A121604E01
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
– The MIL is OFF
(b) Drive Pattern
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 [A].
2. Turn the ignition switch ON [B].
3. Turn the tester ON [C].
4. Clear DTCs (if set) (See page ES-35) [D].
5. Start the engine [E].
6. Start the engine and allow it to idle for 500
seconds or more [F].
7. Drive the vehicle at 25 mph (40 km/h) or more for
at least 2 minutes [G].
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester.
If the status does not switch to COMPL (complete),
make sure that the preconditions of the readiness
monitor on the scan tool display. If readiness status
did not switch to complete, ensure the preconditions
are met, turn the ignition switch OFF and then
repeat steps [E] and [G].
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0657
ES–301
Actuator Supply Voltage Circuit / Open
DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the output voltage to the throttle actuator. This self-check ensures that the ECM is
functioning properly. The output voltage usually is 0 V when the ignition switch is turned OFF. If the output
voltage is higher than 7 V when the ignition switch is turned OFF, the ECM will illuminate the MIL and set
a DTC when the ignition switch is turned ON.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0657
Throttle actuator power supply error
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
None
Required sensors / components (main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (sub)
Throttle actuator
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 1 second
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Ignition switch
From ON to OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Throttle actuator power supply
7 V or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear DTC.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery terminal
and wait for 1 minute.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON for 10 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(g) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(h) Check DTC.
OK:
P0657 is not present.
NG
OK
INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–302
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1340
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" (Bank 1 Sensor
2)
DTC
P1341
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" (Bank 1 Sensor
2)
DESCRIPTION
ES
The camshaft position sensor (G signal) consists of a magnet, iron core and pickup coil.
The camshaft drive gear (LH) has 3 teeth on its inner circumstance. When the camshaft gear rotates, air
gap changes between the protrusion on the gear and the pickup coil. The change affects the magnetic
field and results in changes in the resistance of the MRE element.
The crankshaft signal plate has 32 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The crankshaft position
sensor generates 32 signals at every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle
based on the G signal and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signal.
DTC No.
P1340
P1341
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during
cranking (2 trip detection logic)
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more
•
•
•
•
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Camshaft timing pulley LH
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor (G signal) consists of a magnet and MRE element.
The camshaft drive gear has 5 teeth on its inner circumference. When the camshaft gear rotates, air gap
changes between the protrusion on the gear and the pickup coil. The change affects the magnetic field
and results in changes in the resistance of the MRE element. The crankshaft angle sensor plate has 32
teeth and outputs 32 signals at every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle
based on the G signal and actual crankshaft angle and engine speed by NE signal.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1340: Camshaft position sensor range check
P1340: Camshaft position / Crankshaft position misalignment
P1341: Camshaft position sensor malfunction
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Camshaft position sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, Engine speed sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
5 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles: Camshaft position sensor range check
Immediate: Camshaft position / Crankshaft position misalignment and
camshaft position sensor malfunction
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Camshaft position sensor range check:
Starter
ON
Minimal battery voltage while starter ON
Less than 11 V
Camshaft position / Crankshaft position misalignment:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
ES–303
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Starter
OFF
Camshaft position sensor malfunction:
Starter
After OFF to ON timing
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Camshaft position sensor range check:
Camshaft position signal
No signal
Camshaft position / Crankshaft position misalignment:
Camshaft position and crankshaft position phase
Misaligned
Camshaft position sensor malfunction:
Camshaft position and crankshaft position phase
Misaligned
Camshaft position signal per 2 revolutions of crankshaft
12 signals or more
ES
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
•
Camshaft position sensor signal
•
Camshaft position sensor voltage fluctuates when the camshaft
rotates
3 signals per revolution of crankshaft
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (See page ES-195).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SENSOR POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the C1 camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal 3 of the camshaft
position sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C1-3 - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
(d) Reconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
C1
NG
Front View
A115895E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–304
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK ECM TERMINAL VOLTAGE
(a) Inspect the ECM using an oscilloscope.
(1) While the engine is idling, check the waveform
between the terminals of the ECM connector.
Standard voltage
ECM Connector
E6
ES
G2+
2 V/DIV.
OK
*1
*3
Specified Condition
G2+ (E6-19) - G2- (E6-29)
Correct waveform is as shown
HINT:
• *1: Crank angle
• *2: 180°
• *3: 120°
• *4: 60°
G2-
REPLACE ECM
*4
*3
*2
Tester Connection
*2
*4
200 ms./DIV.
A115714E01
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
Wire Harness Side
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the C1 Camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
C1
Camshaft position sensor (C1-2) G2+ (E6-19)
Camshaft position senssor (C1-1) G2- (E6-29)
Front View
ECM Connector
E6
Camshaft position sensor (C1-2) or
G2+ (E6-19) - Body ground
Camshaft position sensor (C1-1) or
G2- (E6-29) - Body ground
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the Camshaft position sensor connector.
NG
G2+
G2A115715E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–305
OK
4
INSPECT SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a) Check the camshaft position sensor installation.
OK:
The camshaft position sensor is installed properly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SENSOR
Clearance
OK
NG
ES
BR03795E10
OK
5
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY LH (SIGNAL PLATE TOOTH)
NG
OK
REPLACE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY LH
ES–306
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1440
Secondary Air Injection Vacuum Switching
Valve Circuit Malfunction Bank 1
DTC
P1443
Secondary Air Injection Vacuum Switching
Valve Circuit Malfunction Bank 2
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-214).
DTC No.
P1440
ES
P1443
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
AIV1 terminal voltage becomes less than half of the +B
voltage while the VSV for air injection system is not
operating.
(1 trip detection logic)
•
AIV2 terminal voltage becomes less than half of the +B
voltage while the VSV for air injection system is not
operating.
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in VSV for air injection system circuit
(bank 1)
VSV power source
VSV for air injection system (bank 1)
ECM
Open or short in VSV for air injection system circuit
(bank 2)
VSV power source
VSV for air injection system (bank 2)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM detects an open or short in the circuit of the VSV for air injection system according to the AIV1
(AIV2) terminal voltage, stores the DTC, and then illuminates the MIL. When the AIV1 (AIV2) terminal
voltage is less than half of the +B voltage while the VSV for air injection system is not operating, the ECM
determines it as a malfunction.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1440: Secondary air injection system control valve circuit (bank 1) range check
P1443: Secondary air injection system control valve circuit (bank 2) range check
Required sensors/components
VSV for air injection control
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
P1440:
Engine
Running
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1)
Not operating
P1443:
Engine
Running
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2)
Not operating
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P1440:
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1) output terminal level
Low
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–307
P1443:
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2) output terminal level
Low
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-217).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
ES
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INJECTION SYSTEM POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the V12 or V13 VSV for air injection system
connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the VSV
connector and body ground.
Standard:
9 V or more
(d) Reconnect the VSV for air injection system connector.
Wire Harness Side
V12
V13
VSV for Air Injection System Connector
G032727E15
OK
NG
REPAIR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM POWER
SOURCE CIRCUIT
ES–308
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - VSV FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
Wire Harness Side
VSV for Air Injection Control Connector
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(b) Disconnect the VSV for air injection control connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the VSV connector and
ECM.
Standard resistance
V12
Tester connection
Specified condition
AIV1 (E4-27) - V13-2
Below 1 Ω
AIV2 (E4-26) - V12-2
Below 1 Ω
V13
(d) Measure the resistance between the VSV connector and
body ground.
Standard resistance
ES
ECM Connector
E4
Tester connection
Specified condition
AIV1 (E4-27) or V13-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AIV2 (E4-26) or V12-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(f) Reconnect the VSV for air injection control connectors.
NG
AIV1
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AIV2
A121617E07
OK
3
CHECK VSV (RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the V12 or V13 VSV for air injection system
connector.
(b) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the VSV.
(c) Measure the resistance of the VSV terminals.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
33 to 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A115365
(d) Reconnect the VSV for air injection system connector.
(e) Reconnect the vacuum hose.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE VSV
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – VVT SENSOR
ES–489
VVT SENSOR
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT VVT SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance:
Cold:
835 to 1,400 Ω
Hot:
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" above mean the temperature
of the coils themselves. "Cold" is from -10°C
(14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C
(122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
ES
ES–309
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1441
Stuck Open in Secondary Air Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank 1
DTC
P1444
Stuck Open in Secondary Air Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank 2
DTC
P2440
Secondary Air Injection System Switching
Valve Stuck Open Bank1
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-214).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1441
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1) stuck open:
The pressure sensor detects exhaust pulsation, when both
of No. 2 air switching valve OFF (and air switching valve
ON).
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
VSV for air injection system circuit (bank 1)
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1)
VSV for air injection system (bank 1)
ECM
P1444
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2) stuck open:
The pressure sensor detects exhaust pulsation, when both
of No. 2 air switching valve OFF (and air switching valve
ON).
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
VSV for air injection system circuit (bank 2)
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2)
VSV for air injection system (bank 2)
ECM
P2440
No. 2 air switching valve stuck open:
The pressure sensor detects exhaust pulsation when the
system is not operating (both of No. 2 air switching valve
OFF, and air switching valve OFF and air pump OFF).
This DTC means air switching valve and "No. 2 air
switching valve bank 1 or bank 2" are stuck open.
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air switching valve (ASV)
No. 2 air switching valve (Bank 1 and/or 2)
VSV for air injection system (bank 1 and/or 2)
Air injection control driver (AID)
Air injection control driver circuit
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM detects pressure change with the pressure sensor to determine malfunctioning parts in the
system, and stores the DTCs. The ECM measures pressure and/or exhaust pulsation of the system at 6
points, A to F, when the air injection system is in operation or when not in operation. When the pressure is
high, the ECM determines that the pump operates. When exhaust pulsation is detected, the ECM
determines that the Air Switching Valve (ASV) is open. The ECM determines malfunction parts based on
the measured value, and stores the DTCs.
Points A and B:
ECM detects pressure changes (decrease), and determines that the No. 2 Air Switching Valve (No. 2
ASV) is open.
Points C and F:
ECM detects pressure and exhaust pulsation, and determines the pressure pattern of the system.
Point D:
ECM operates the system, as indicated by the dashed lines, to determine which of the No. 2 ASV is
malfunctioning only when pressure changes cannot be detected at point A or B.
Point E:
ECM detects exhaust pulsation to determine the condition of the system.
ES
ES–310
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Monitor Operation Outline
Running
ES
Engine
OFF
Air Pump
ON
OFF
ASV
(Electromagnetic Type)
ON
No. 2 ASV (Bank 1)
(Vacuum Type)*
ON
OFF
No. 2 ASV (Bank 2)
(Vacuum Type)*
ON
OFF
OFF
System Air Pressure
A B
C
D
E
F
*: No. 2 ASV opens alternately per trip.
A115364E02
Pressure condition in Secondary Air Injection System (Point C and F)
Pattern 1:
Air Pump
ON
Air Switching Valve and No. 2 Air Switching Valve
Open
Pressure
1 kPa or more
Pulsation detection
Exhaust gas pulsation detected
Pattern 2:
Air Pump
OFF
Air Switching Valve and No. 2 Air Switching Valve
Open
Pressure
Less than 5 kPa
Pulsation detection
Exhaust gas pulsation detected
Air Pump
ON
Pattern 3:
Air Switching Valve and No. 2 Air Switching Valve
Closed
Pressure
1 kPa or more
Pulsation detection
Slight pulsation detected
Air Pump
OFF
Pattern 4:
Air Switching Valve and No. 2 Air Switching Valve
Closed
Pressure
Less than 5 kPa
Pulsation detection
Not detected
ES–311
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Judgment and decision of failure mode:
Monitor
Judgment
C
F
A
B
D
E
DTCs that may
be set
Pattern 1
Pattern 1
Pressure changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P2444, P1441
and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 1
No pressure
changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P2444 and
"P1441 or P1444"
Pattern 1
Pattern 1
Pressure changed
No pressure
changed
Pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P2444, P1441
and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 1
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
Pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P2444, P1441
and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 2
Pressure changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P1441 and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 2
No pressure
changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P1441 or P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 2
Pressure changed
No pressure
changed
Pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P1441 and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 2
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
Pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P1441 and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 3
Pressure changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P2444
Pattern 1
Pattern 3
No pressure
changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P2444 and
"P1442 or P1445"
Pattern 1
Pattern 3
Pressure changed
No pressure
changed
No pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P2444 and
"P1442 or P1445"
Pattern 1
Pattern 3
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
No pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P2444, P1442
and P1444
Pattern 1
Pattern 4
Pressure changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
Normal
Pattern 1
Pattern 4
Pressure changed
No pressure
changed
Pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
Normal
Pattern 1
Pattern 4
Pressure changed
No pressure
changed
No pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P1442 or P1445
Pattern 1
Pattern 4
No pressure
changed
Pressure changed
-
No pulsation
detected
P1442 or P1445
Pattern 1
Pattern 4
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
Pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P1442 or P1445
Pattern 1
Pattern 4
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
No pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P1442 and P1445
Pattern 2
-
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
-
-
P2445
Pattern 3
Pattern 3
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
No pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P2441, P2444,
P1442 and P1445
Pattern 3
Pattern 4
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
No pulsation
detected
No pulsation
detected
P2441, P1442
and P1445
Pattern 4
-
No pressure
changed
No pressure
changed
-
-
P2445
-
-
-
-
-
Pulsation
detected
P2440 and
"P1441 or P1444"
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1441 Air valve bank 1 open stuck
P1444 Air valve bank 2 open stuck
P1441 and P1444 Air valve bank 1 and bank 2 open stuck
P2440 Air valve open stuck
P2440 Air valve bank 1 and bank 2 open stuck
Required sensors/Components (main)
AIR valve, AIR VSV bank 1, AIR VSV bank 2
ES
ES–312
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/Components (sub)
AIR pressure sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 20 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: P1441and P1444
Immediate: P2440
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
ES
This monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0010, P0020: VVT system
P0011: VVT System 1 - Advance
P0012: VVT System 1 - Retard
P0016, P0018: VVT System - Misalignment
P0021: VVT System 2 - Advance
P0022: VVT System 2 - Retard
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052: Front A/F sensor heater
P0100 - P0103: MAF sensor
P0110 - P0113: IAT sensor
P0115 - P0118: ECT sensor
P0120 - P0223, P2125: TP sensor
P0125: Closed loop
P0171 - P0175: Fuel trim
P0300 - P0308: Misfire
P0327 - P0333: Knock sensor
P0335: CKP sensor
P0340 - P0346: VVT sensor
P0351 - P0358: Igniter
P0445 - P0446: EVAP system
P0450 - P0453: EVAP press sensor
P0500: VSS
P2196, P2198: A/F sensor - rationality
P2237, P2240: A/F sensor - open
P2430 - P2433: AIR pressure sensor
P2A00, P2A03: A/F sensor - slow response
Case 1:
Atmospheric pressure
45 kPa (420 mmHg) or higher
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Case 2:
Atmospheric pressure
45 kPa (420 mmHg) or higher
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
AIR pump
OFF
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
AIR valve bank 1
OFF
AIR valve bank 2
OFF
AIR status
OFF
Engine load
0 % or more
Intake air amount
40 g/sec. or more
IAT at engine start
-15°C (5°F) or higher
ECT at engine start
Lower than 5°C (41°F)
AIR valve
ON
Engine RPM
Lower than 3,750 rpm
Case 3:
Cumulative intake air amount
109 g/sec. or more
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
OFF
AIR valve bank 1
OFF
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
AIR valve bank 2
OFF
Engine RPM
Lower than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
ES–313
AIR monitor runs in accordance with the monitor sequence 1 to 5
Monitor Sequence 1
Idle
ON
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
Either of following conditions 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
ON
-AIR valve bank 2
OFF
2. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
OFF
-AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 2
Idle
ON
AIR status
ON
AIR valve
ON
AIR VSV bank 1
ON
AIR VSV bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 3
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
AIR valve bank 1
ON
AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 4-1
Runs when AIR pressure did not change at monitor sequence 2
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
Either of following conditions 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
ON
-AIR valve bank 2
OFF
2. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
OFF
-AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 4-2
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
OFF
AIR VSV bank 1
OFF
AIR VSV bank 2
OFF
Monitor Sequence 5
ES
ES–314
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
ON
AIR VSV bank 1
OFF
AIR VSV bank 2
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P1441 AIR valve bank 1 open stuck:
ES
When both conditions below are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. When one of the following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
20 kPa or more
AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
(b) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
30 kPa or more
AIR pressure
5 kPa or more
(c) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
20 kPa or more
AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
2. When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) or (2)
(1) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 1
2.5 kPa or more
(2) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 2
2.5 kPa or more
(b) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 1 (for AIR valve bank 1)
Less than 1 kPa
(c) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 2 (for AIR valve bank 1)
Less than 1 kPa
P1444 AIR valve bank 2 open stuck:
When both conditions below are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. When one of the following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
20 kPa or more
AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
(b) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
30 kPa or more
AIR pressure
5 kPa or more
(c) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
Cumulative pressure pulsation
20 kPa or more
AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
2. When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) or (2)
(1) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 1
2.5 kPa or more
(2) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 2
2.5 kPa or more
(b) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 1 (for AIR valve bank 2)
Less than 1 kPa
(c) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 2 (for AIR valve bank 2)
Less than 1 kPa
ES–315
P1441 and P1444 AIR valve bank 1 and bank 2 open stuck:
Cumulative pressure pulsation
100 kPa or more
P2440 AIR valve open stuck:
When both of conditions are met (during AIR ON):
Condition 1 and 2
1. Cumulative pressure pulsation
15 kPa or more
2. AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
Cumulative pressure pulsation during monitor sequence 4-2
20 kPa or more
P2440 AIR valve bank 1 and bank 2 open stuck:
Cumulative pressure pulsation
100 kPa or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to Checking Monitor Status (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-217).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO SECONDARY AIR INJECTION
SYSTEM DTCS)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
ES
ES–316
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
"P1441 and/or P1444" and P2440
A
P1441 and/or P1444
B
"P1441 and/or P1444 and/or P2440" and other DTCs
C
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P1441, P1444 or P2440 are
output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
ES
C
Go to step 7
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK AIR SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Remove the Air Switching Valve (ASV).
(c) Blow air into port A and check that air is not discharged
from port B.
OK:
Not discharged
Air
Port A
Port B
G032728E01
Port B
Air
Battery
(d) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(e) Blow air into port A and check that air is discharged from
port B.
OK:
Discharged
NG
Port A
G032729E02
OK
REPLACE AIR SWITCHING VALVE
ES–317
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK AIR SWITCHING VALVE (VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
A47
Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
Disconnect the A47 ASV connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the air
switching valve connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
ASV Connector
G032727E10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A47-1 - Body ground
Below 1.0 V
(e) Reconnect the ASV connector.
NG
Go to step 4
ES
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER - AIR
SWITCHING VALVE)
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Control Driver Connector
A44
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
Disconnect the A44 air injection driver connector.
Disconnect the A47 air switching valve connector.
Disconnect the battery positive terminal cable.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VV (A44-6) - A47-1
Below 1 Ω
VV (A44-6) or A47-1 - Battery positive
terminal cable
10 kΩ or higher
VV
(f) Reconnect the air injection driver connector.
(g) Reconnect the ASV connector.
Air Switching Valve Connector
NG
A47
A121615E04
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–318
5
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER (VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the A44 Air Injection Control Driver (AID)
connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal 3 (SIV) of the AID
connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A44
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SIV (A44-3) - Body ground
10 V or more
SIV
AID Connector
G032721E22
(d) Reconnect the AID connector.
NG
ES
Go to step 6
OK
REPLACE AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the air injection driver connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Control Driver Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SIV (A44-3) - AIRV (E8-4)
Below 1 Ω
SIV (A44-3) or AIRV (E8-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A44
SIV
(d) Reconnect the air injection driver connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ECM Connector
E8
NG
AIRV
A121716E06
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
ES–319
CHECK NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A116419
Air switching valve No. 2 operation
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Start the engine and push the intelligent tester main
switch ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
/ OPERATION 5 and 6.
HINT:
OPERATION 5: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: OPEN;
ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 6: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: CLOSE;
ASV2: OPEN
NOTICE:
• This test only allows technicians to operate the
AIR system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test
can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is
repeated, intervals of at least 30 seconds are
required between tests.
While the AIR system operation using the
intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI
STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
(f) Read values of the A/F BANK1 and BANK2 on the
intelligent tester.
Result
Air fuel ratio
Open
18 or more
Closed
Approximately 14.5
HINT:
• When the No. 2 ASV operates normally, the A/F value
is 18 or more when the valve is open, and
approximately 14.5 when the valve is closed.
• Perform the following procedures only on the bank of
which the valve is not closed.
NEXT
ES
ES–320
8
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK VSV (FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
Port A
A121720E01
ES
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the VSV for air
injection system.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
/ OPERATION 1.
(f) At this time, check that no negative pressure generates
at port A of the VSV.
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF; EASV: CLOSE; ASV1:
CLOSE; ASV2: CLOSE
NOTICE:
• This test only allows technicians to operate the
AIR system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test
can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is
repeated, intervals of at least 30 seconds are
required between tests.
While the AIR system operation using the
intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI
STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch to OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
OK:
No negative pressure is generated.
(g) Reconnect the vacuum hose.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
9
CHECK NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a) Remove the No. 2 air switching valve.
(b) Blow air into port B and check that air is not discharged
from port C.
OK:
Not discharged from port C
Port A
Port C
Air
Port B
G032732E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–321
(c) Apply vacuum 30 kPa (225 mmHg) to port A, blow air
into port B and check that air is discharged from port C.
OK:
Discharged from port C
Port A
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
Port B
Air
Port C
G032733E01
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
10
ES
CHECK VSV (FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
(a) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses.
(b) Disconnect the VSV for air injection system connector.
(c) Blow air into port B and check that air does not flow from
port A.
OK:
Air does not flow from port A
(d) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals. Then
blow air into port B and check that air flows from port A.
OK:
Air flows from port A
Port A
Air
NG
Port A
Air
A138066E01
OK
REPLACE VSV
ES–322
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
11
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - VSV FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
Wire Harness Side
VSV for Air Injection Control Connector
V12
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Disconnect the V12 and V13 VSV for air injection system
control connector.
(d) Measure the resistance between the VSV connector and
ECM.
Standard resistance
V13
ES
Tester connection
Specified condition
AIV1 (E4-27) - V13-2
Below 1 Ω
AIV2 (E4-26) - V12-2
Below 1 Ω
(e) Measure the resistance between the VSV connector and
body ground.
Standard resistance
ECM Connector
E4
Tester connection
Specified condition
AIV1 (E4-27) or V13-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AIV2 (E4-26) or V12-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(f) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(g) Reconnect the VSV connector.
NG
AIV1
AIV2
A121617E07
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–323
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1442
Stuck Close in Secondary Air Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank 1
DTC
P1445
Stuck Close in Secondary Air Injection Vacuum
Switching Valve Bank 2
DTC
P2441
Secondary Air Injection System Switching
Valve Stuck Close Bank1
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-214).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
P1442
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1) stuck closed:
No pressure change (decrease) after the ECM sends an
open No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1) signal.
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
P1445
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2) stuck closed:
No pressure change (decrease) after the ECM sends an
open No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2) signal.
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
P2441
Air switching valve stuck closed:
The pressure sensor does not detect exhaust pulsation
when system operates. (All of air switching valve ON)
This DTC means either of the following conditions is met.
1. Electromagnetic air switching valve stuck closed.
2. Both of "No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1)" and "No. 2
air switching valve (Bank 2)" are stuck closed.
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
VSV for air injection system circuit (bank 1)
Vacuum hose (VSV for air injection system - No. 2
air switching valve)
Air injector pipe (No. 2 air switching valve - exhaust
manifold)
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1)
VSV for air injection system (bank 1)
ECM
VSV for air injection system circuit (Bank 2)
Vacuum hose (VSV for air injection system - No. 2
air switching valve )
Air injector pipe (No. 2 air switching valve - exhaust
manifold)
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 2)
VSV for air injection system (bank 2)
ECM
Vacuum hoses (Throttle body - VSVs for air
injection system)
Air switching valve
Air injector pipe (No. 2 air switching valve - exhaust
manifold)
Air injection hose
No. 2 air switching valve (bank 1 and/or 2)
VSV for air injection system (bank 1 and/or 2)
Air injection control driver
Air injection control driver circuit
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P1441, P1444 and P2440 (See page ES-304).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
(Case 1) P1442 AIR VSV stuck close bank 1
(Case 2) P1445 AIR VSV stuck close bank 2
(Case 3) P2441 AIR valve stuck close
Required sensors/Components (main)
AIR valve, AIR VSV bank 1, AIR VSV bank 2
Required sensors/Components (sub)
AIR pressure sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 20 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
ES
ES–324
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
This monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Atmospheric pressure
45 kPa (420 mmHg) or more
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
ES
P0010, P0020: VVT system
P0011: VVT System 1 - Advance
P0012: VVT System 1 - Retard
P0016, P0018: VVT System - Misalignment
P0021: VVT System 2 - Advance
P0022: VVT System 2 - Retard
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052: Front A/F sensor heater
P0100 - P0103: MAF sensor
P0110 - P0113: IAT sensor
P0115 - P0118: ECT sensor
P0120 - P0223, P2125: TP sensor
P0125: Closed loop
P0171 - P0175: Fuel trim
P0300 - P0308: Misfire
P0327 - P0333: Knock sensor
P0335: CKP sensor
P0340 - P0346: VVT sensor
P0351 - P0358: Igniter
P0445 - P0446: EVAP system
P0450 - P0453: EVAP press sensor
P0500: VSS
P2196, P2198: A/F sensor - rationality
P2237, P2240: A/F sensor - open
P2430 - P2433: AIR pressure sensor
P2A00, P2A03: A/F sensor - slow response
AIR monitor runs in accordance with the monitor sequence 1 to 5
Monitor Sequence 1
Idle
ON
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
Either of following conditions 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
ON
-AIR valve bank 2
OFF
2. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
OFF
-AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 2
Idle
ON
AIR status
ON
AIR valve
ON
AIR VSV bank 1
ON
AIR VSV bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 3
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
AIR valve bank 1
ON
AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 4-1
Runs when AIR pressure did not change at monitor sequence 2
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
Either of following conditions 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
ON
-AIR valve bank 2
OFF
2. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
OFF
-AIR valve bank 2
ON
ES–325
Monitor Sequence 4-2
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
OFF
AIR VSV bank 1
OFF
AIR VSV bank 2
OFF
Monitor Sequence 5
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
ON
AIR VSV bank 1
OFF
AIR VSV bank 2
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P1442 AIR valve bank 1 close stuck
When both conditions below are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b), (c) or (d)
(a) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 30 kPa
- AIR pressure
5 kPa or more
(b) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 20 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
(c) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 30 kPa
- AIR pressure
5 kPa or more
ES
ES–326
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) or (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 20 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
2. When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 1 (for AIR valve bank1)
Less than 1 kPa
(b) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 2 (for AIR valve bank1)
Less than 1 kPa
(c) Cumulative pressure pulsation during monitor sequence 4-1 (for
AIR valve bank 1)
Less than 15 kPa
P1445 AIR valve bank 2 close stuck
ES
When both conditions below are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b), (c) or (d)
(a) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 30 kPa
- AIR pressure
5 kPa or more
(b) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
(2) When both conditions below are met:
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 20 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
(c) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) and (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 30 kPa
- AIR pressure
5 kPa or more
(d) When both conditions below are met:
Condition (1) or (2)
(1) When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 1 kPa
(2) When both conditions below are met (during AIR OFF):
-
- Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 20 kPa
- AIR pressure
Less than 5 kPa
2. When one of following conditions is met:
Condition (a), (b) or (c)
(a) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 1 (for AIR valve bank2)
Less than 1 kPa
(b) AIR pressure change at monitor sequence 2 (for AIR valve bank2)
Less than 1 kPa
(c) Cumulative pressure pulsation during monitor sequence 4-1 (for
AIR valve bank 2)
Less than 15 kPa
P2441 AIR valve close stuck
When both conditions below are met (during AIR ON)
Condition 1 and 2
ES–327
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. Cumulative pressure pulsation
Less than 15 kPa
2. AIR pressure
1 kPa or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-217).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO SECONDARY AIR INJECTION
SYSTEM DTCS)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
"P1442 and/or P1445" and P2441
A
P1442 and/or P1445
B
"P1442 and/or P1445 and/or P2441" and other DTCs
C
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P1441 and/or P1444 and P2440
are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
C
A
Go to step 5
GO TO DTC CHART
ES
ES–328
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK VACUUM HOSES (THROTTLE BODY - VSV FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
(a) Check that the vacuum hoses between the throttle body
and VSV for air injection system are securely connected.
OK:
The vacuum hoses are securely connected.
(b) Inspect the vacuum hoses for blockages and damage.
OK:
The vacuum hoses have no blockages and
damage.
A121722
ES
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
OK
3
CHECK PIPES AND HOSES (CONNECTION OF AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
G032737E01
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Check all pipes and hoses of the air injection system.
OK:
All air injection pipes and hoses are securely
connected.
(c) Check all pipes and hoses of the air injection system for
blockage or damage.
OK:
All air injection pipes or hoses have no blockages
or damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INJECTION
SYSTEM PIPING AND HOSES
OK
4
CHECK AIR SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Remove the Air Switching Valve (ASV).
(c) Blow air into port A and check that air is not discharged
from port B.
OK:
Not discharged
Air
Port A
Port B
G032728E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–329
(d) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(e) Blow air into port A and check that air is discharged from
port B.
OK:
Discharged
Port B
Air
Battery
NG
Port A
REPLACE AIR SWITCHING VALVE AND GO
TO STEP 6
G032729E02
OK
5
CHECK NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A116419
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
/ OPERATION 5 and 6.
HINT:
OPERATION 5: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: OPEN;
ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 6: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: CLOSE;
ASV2: OPEN
NOTICE:
• This test only allows technicians to operate the
AIR system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test
can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is
repeated, intervals of at least 30 seconds are
required between tests.
While the AIR system operation using the
intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI
STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
(f) Read values of the A/F BANK1 and BANK2 on the
intelligent tester.
Result
Air switching valve No. 2 operation
Air fuel ratio
Open
18 or more
Closed
Approximately 14.5
ES
ES–330
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
• When the No. 2 ASV operates normally, the A/F
value is 18 or more when the valve is open, and
approximately 14.5 when the valve is closed.
• Perform the following procedures only on the bank of
which the valve is not open.
NEXT
6
CHECK VSV (FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
Port A
ES
A121723E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vacuum hoses from the VSV for the air
injection system.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
(e) When the air switching valve is operated using the
intelligent tester, check that negative pressure from port
A.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
/ OPERATION 2.
HINT:
OPERATION 2: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: OPEN;
ASV2: OPEN
NOTICE:
• This test only allows technicians to operate the
AIR system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test
can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is
repeated, intervals of at least 30 seconds are
required between tests.
While the AIR system operation using the
intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI
STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
OK:
Negative pressure from port A
(g) Reconnect the vacuum hose.
NG
OK
Go to step 10
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
ES–331
CHECK VACUUM HOSES (AIR SWITCHING VALVE - VSV FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
(a) Check that the vacuum hoses between the No. 2 air
switching valve(s) and VSV for the air injection system
are securely connected.
OK:
The vacuum hose(s) are securely connected.
(b) Check the vacuum hoses for blockages and damage.
OK:
The vacuum hoses have no blockages and
damage.
A121724
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
ES
OK
8
CHECK NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a) Remove the No. 2 air switching valve.
Port A
Port C
Air
Port B
G032732E01
(b) Blow air into port B and check that air is not discharged
from port C.
OK:
Not discharged from port C
(c) Apply vacuum 30 kPa (225 mmHg) to port A, blow air
into port B and check that air is discharged from port C.
OK:
Discharged from port C
Port A
Port B
Air
OK
Port C
G032733E01
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
ES–332
9
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK AIR INJECTION PIPE (NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE - EXHAUST MANIFOLD)
(a) Check that the air injection pipe between the No. 2 air
switching valve(s) and exhaust manifold are securely
connected.
OK:
The air injection pipe is securely connected.
(b) Check the air injection pipe for blockages and damage.
OK:
The air injection pipe has no blockages and
damage.
G032739E01
ES
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INJECTION PIPE
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
10
CHECK VSV (FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
(a) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses.
(b) Disconnect the VSV for the air injection system
connector.
(c) Blow air into port B. Check that air does not flow from
port A.
OK:
Air does not flow from port A
(d) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals. Then
blow air into port B and check that air flows from port A.
OK:
Air flows from port A
A
Air
NG
A
Air
A138067E01
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE VSV
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1613
ES–333
Secondary Air Injection Driver Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-214).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1613
Either of following condition (a) or (b) is met:
(a) Both of following conditions are met (1 trip detection logic):
– While either of air pump or air switching valve does not
operate
– Air injection control driver outputs normal signal (80 %
duty signal)
(b) Following condition is met (1 trip detection logic):
– Air injection control driver outputs abnormal duty signal
(duty signal excluding 0, 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 %)
P1613
Both of following conditions are met (1 trip detection logic):
(a) While air injection system operating (Air pump ON and all
ASV ON)
(b) Air injection control driver outputs air pump malfunction
signal (0 % duty signal)
P1613
Air injection control driver outputs abnormal duty signal (100
% duty signal) (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
Air injection control driver (AID)
Open in air injection control driver ground circuit
•
•
•
•
•
Short in diagnostic information signal circuit (AID - ECM)
Open or short in air pump and air switching valve
command signal circuit (AID - ECM)
Air injection control driver (AID)
Open in air injection control driver ground circuit
ECM
•
•
•
•
Open or short in AID power source circuit
Open in diagnostic information signal circuit (AID - ECM)
Air injection control driver (AID)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When the air injection system operation is required while the engine is warming up, the ECM transmits
command signals to the Air Injection Control Driver (AID) to drive the air pump and Air Switching Valve
(ASV).
AID detects an open and short in the air pump and air switching valve circuit according to the terminal
voltage and sends a signal as the diagnostic information to the ECM.
If the air injection system drive circuit or the AID itself has a malfunction, the AID sends a malfunction
signal (duty signal) as a diagnostic information signal to the ECM (when the system is normal, a system
normal signal is sent).
The ECM sets the DTC based on the diagnostic information from the AID.
Example:
1. The duty ratio of the diagnostic information signal output from AID is 0 or 100 % (remains at 0 V or
battery voltage).
2. The duty ratio of the diagnostic signal from the AID shows an impossible ratio (other than 0, 20, 40, 60,
80, 100 %).
3. The AID outputs the normal signal (normal duty signal: 80 %) while the system is not operating.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1613: Secondary air injection system control module range check
Required sensors/components
Air injection control driver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
ES
ES–334
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Case 1:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
Case 2:
Either of following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Air pump
Not operating
2. Air switching valve
Not operating
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
Case 3:
ES
Air pump
Operating
Air switching valve
Operating
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
Case 4:
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1:
One of the following conditions is met
Condition 1, 2, 3 or 4
1. Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control
driver
1 to 10 %
2. Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control
driver
30 %
3. Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control
driver
49 %
4. Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control
driver
91 to 99 %
Case 2:
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
70 to 90 %
Case 3:
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
0%
Case 4:
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
100 %
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Diagnostic signal duty ratio from air injection control driver
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-217).
70 to 90 % when secondary air injection system is operating
and
0 % when secondary air injection system is not operating
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–335
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The diagnostic information output from the Air Injection Control Driver (AID) can be confirmed by
connecting an oscilloscope to the diagnostic information terminal of the AID. A trouble area search can be
narrowed by reading the waveform on the oscilloscope when performing the AIR system intrusive
operation function provided in the SYSTEM CHECK.
1. Start the engine and warm it up.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
4. Connect an oscilloscope probe to the AIDI terminal of the ECM.
ECM Connector
ES
E1
AIDI
G035614E71
5. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
6. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR
INJ SYSTEM.
7. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR
INJ CHECK / MANUAL / OPERATION 1 and 2.
AIR INJ CHECK
AIR PUMP
ON
EASV
OPEN
ASV1
OPEN
ASV2
OPEN
A/F BANK1
19.05
A/F BANK2
19.05
PRESSURE
17kPa-g
PULSATION
25.39kPa-g
AI STATUS
OK
Remaining Time 05 sec.
Press [EXIT] to quit
A133735
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF; EASV: CLOSE; ASV1: CLOSE; ASV2: OFF
OPERATION 2: AP: ON; EASV: OPEN; ASV1: OPEN; ASV2: OPEN
ES–336
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8. Monitor the voltage output of the AID (duty ratio signal).
Example: 80% Duty Signal
5 V/DIV.
GND
20 msec./DIV.
ES
A116420E03
Oscilloscope range
Item
Content
Terminal
CH1: AIDI - E1
Equipment Setting
5 V/DIV., 20 to 40 msec./DIV.
Condition
Idling
NOTICE:
• This AIR INJECTION CHECK only allows technicians to operate the AIR system for 5
seconds. Furthermore, the check can be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated,
intervals of at least 30 seconds are required between checks.
While the AIR system operation using the intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop
the engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• Performing the AIR INJ CHECK over and over again may cause damage in the secondary air
injection system. If necessary, wait several minutes between tests to prevent overheating the
system.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation after the battery cable has been
reconnected, wait for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ CHECK operation finishes.
AID Diagnostic Signal
Waveform
ECM Command
DTC
(ECM Output)
Suspected Trouble Area
•
•
100 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 1
Any Air Injection (AIR) System
operation
P1613
•
•
•
0 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 2
AIR System: ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
P1613
•
•
•
•
AIR System: OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
-
Open in diagnostic signal
circuit
Air Injection Control Driver
(AID)
Open in AID +B circuit (AID
power source)
Short between +B circuit and
diagnostic signal circuit
Open or short in air pump or
Air Switching Valve (ASV)
command signal circuit (ECM
- AID)
Open in AID ground circuit
Short between diagnostic
signal circuit and body
ground
AID
ECM
Normal
ES–337
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
AID Diagnostic Signal
Waveform
DTC
(ECM Output)
ECM Command
Suspected Trouble Area
•
•
Air Pump: ON
P0418
•
•
•
20 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 3
•
Air Pump: OFF
P0418
•
•
•
•
•
•
ASV: ON
P0412
•
•
•
40 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 4
•
ASV: OFF
80 % Duty Ratio
See waveform 5
Excluding Above
(excluding 0, 20, 40, 80, 100 %
duty)
P0412
Short between air pump drive
circuit and body ground
Harness & connector (AID Pump)
Air Pump
AID
ECM
Open in air pump drive circuit
(AID - Pump), or short
between air pump drive
circuit and +B
Harness & connector (AID Pump)
Air Pump
AID
ECM
Short between ASV drive
circuit and body ground
Harness & connector (AID ASV)
ASV
AID
ECM
•
•
•
Open in ASV drive circuit
(AID - ASV), or short between
ASV drive circuit and +B
Harness & connector (AID ASV)
AID
ASV
ECM
AID
ECM
•
AIR System: OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
P1613
•
•
AIR System: ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
-
Normal
-
P1613
•
•
1.
Almost Same as Battery Voltage
+B
GND
A112066E01
Waveform 1
100 % Duty Ratio
AID
Open in AID ground circuit
ES
ES–338
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2.
Waveform 2
0 % Duty Ratio
3.
Waveform 3
20 % Duty Ratio
4.
Waveform 4
40 % Duty Ratio
5.
Waveform 5
80 % Duty Ratio
+B
Fixed at Low Voltage
GND
A112067E01
20%
ES
+B
GND
A112068E01
40%
+B
GND
A112069E01
80%
+B
GND
A112070E01
HINT:
• Using the AIR INJ CHECK operation of the SYSTEM CHECK provided in the intelligent tester function,
conditions for air fuel ratio and pressure in the secondary air injection system passage can be checked
while the secondary air injection system is operating. It helps technicians to troubleshoot the system
when it is malfunctioning.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–339
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P1613)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P1613
A
P1613 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P1613 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (AIDI VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
E8
AIDI
E118165E02
Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
•
Fixed at Low (1.6 V or less)
even when AIR system ON
(Air pump ON, ASV ON)
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Start the engine.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK /
AUTOMATIC.
NOTICE:
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
(g) Measure the voltage between AIDI terminal of the ECM
connector and body ground when the air injection
system is ON and OFF.
Result
•
•
•
•
•
Short between air pump or air switching
valve command signal circuit and body
ground
Open in air pump command signal circuit
(between ECM and AID)
Open in ASV command signal circuit
(between ECM and AID)
Open in AID ground circuit (between AID
and body ground)
Diagnostic signal circuit ground short
AID
ECM
Proceed to
A
ES
ES–340
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
ES
Fixed at High (12 V or more)
even when AIR system OFF
(Air pump OFF, ASV OFF)
•
Other than above:
• Fluctuating (duty signal excluding
20, 40, 80 %)
•
•
•
•
•
Proceed to
Open in diagnostic signal circuit (ECM AID)
Short between +B circuit and diagnostic
signal circuit (ECM - AID)
Open in AID power source circuit
AID
ECM
B
AID
Open in AID ground circuit (between AID
and body ground)
C
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 8
A
3
INSPECT ECM (AIRP AND AIRV VOLTAGE)
AIRV
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage between terminal E8-25 (AIRP),
E8-4 (AIRV) of the ECM connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
E8
Tester Connection
AIRP (E8-25) - Body ground
10 V or more
AIRV (E8-4) - Body ground
10 V or more
AIRP
E118166E02
OK
Specified Condition
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES–341
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER, AIR
INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER - BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Control Driver Connector
(a) Disconnect the A44 air injection driver connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
A44
E
DI
SIV
SIP
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
SIV (A44-3) or AIRV (E8-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
E (A44-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(d) Measure the voltage between terminals DI (A44-2) and
E(A44-1) of the air injection driver wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
E8
AIRV
AIRP
Tester Connection
SIP (A44-4) or AIRP (E8-25) - Body
ground
A121714E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
DI (A44-2) - E (A44-1)
9 V or more
(e) Reconnect air injection driver connector.
(f) Reconnect ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER
5
CHECK POWER SOURCE OF AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER
(a) Disconnect the A44 Air Injection Control Driver (AID)
connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal +B (A44-5)
and E (A44-1) of the AID connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A44
E
+B
AID Connector
G032721E23
OK
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
+B (A44-5) - E (A44-1)
10 V or more
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–342
6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER (DI TERMINAL VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the A44 AID connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal A44-2 (DI) of
the AID connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A44
DI
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
DI (A44-2) - Body ground
10 V or more
(d) Reconnect the AID connector.
AID Connector
G032721E24
OK
ES
REPLACE AIR INJECTION CONTROL
DRIVER
NG
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Control Driver Connector
(a) Disconnect the A44 air injection driver connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
A44
DI
+B
AIDI
A121715E02
REPLACE ECM
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
DI (A44-2) or AIDI (E8-13) - +B (A44-5)
10 kΩ or higher
NG
E8
OK
Tester Connection
DI (A44-2) - AIDI (E8-13)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–343
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INJECTION DRIVER - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the A44 AID connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminal E (A44-1)
of the AID connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
A44
E
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E (A44-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reconnect the AID connector.
AID Connector
G032721E25
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
OK
9
REPLACE AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER
(a) Replace the AID.
NEXT
10
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P1613)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35).
Start the engine.
Perform ACTIVE TEST to operate the air injection
system.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK /
AUTOMATIC.
After operating the secondary air injection system,
confirm the pending codes of the secondary air injection
system by entering the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
NOTICE:
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
OK:
DTC P1613 for the secondary air injection system
is not output.
NG
GO TO DTC CHART
ES–344
OK
END
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–345
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2102
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit Low
DTC
P2103
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
The throttle actuator is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor which is mounted on the
throttle body. The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM. This feedback allows the ECM to
control the throttle actuator and monitor the throttle opening angle as the ECM responds to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P2102
Following conditions are met for 2 seconds (1 trip
detection logic):
• Throttle actuator duty-cycle is 80% or more
• Throttle actuator current is below 0.5 A or less
•
•
•
Open in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
ECM
P2103
Either of the following condition is met:
• Hybrid IC diagnosis signal fail
• Hybrid IC current limiter port fail
•
•
•
•
•
Short in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
Throttle valve
Throttle bod
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the flow of electrical current through the electronic throttle actuator, and detects
malfunctions or open circuits in the throttle actuator based on the value of the electrical current. When the
current deviates from the standard values, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the throttle actuator.
Or, if the throttle valve is not functioning properly (for example, stuck ON), the ECM concludes that there
is a fault and illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECM determines that the current has deviated from the standard values when one of the following is
detected: 1) the current is more than 10 A, or 2) the actuator driving duty ratio exceeds 80% and the
current is less than 0.5 A. Then the ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2102: Throttle actuator current (low current)
P2103: Throttle actuator current (high current)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Throttle actuator (throttle body)
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
P2102:
Throttle actuator
ON
Duty ratio to open throttle actuator
80 % or more
Throttle power supply
8 V or more
Motor current change during latest 0.016 seconds
Less than 0.2 A
ES
ES–346
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P2103:
Throttle actuator
ON
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
2. Throttle actuator power
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2102:
Throttle actuator current
Less than 0.5 A (when motor drive duty 80 % or more)
P2103:
ES
When either condition below is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Hybrid IC diagnosis signal
Fail
2. Hybrid IC current limiter port
Fail
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 7° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned OFF.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0120 (See page ES-122).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY (RESISTANCE OF THROTTLE ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle body assembly connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the throttle actuator.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Throttle Actuator
T2
NG
M+
MA059778E37
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M+ (T2-2) - M- (T2-1)
0.3 to 100 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY
ES–347
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THROTTLE ACTUATOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side
Throttle Body Assembly Connector
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle body assembly connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
T2
M+ (T2-2) - M+ (E4-5)
M- (T2-1) - M- (E4-4)
M-
E4
Front View
M+
M+ (T2-2) or M+ (E4-5) - Body ground
M- (T2-1) or M- (E4-4) - Body ground
M-
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the throttle body assembly connector.
ECM Connector
NG
M+
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
A115716E02
OK
3
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY (VISUALLY CHECK THROTTLE VALVE)
(a) Check between the throttle valve and the housing for
foreign objects. Also check if the valve can open and
close smoothly.
OK:
The throttle valve is not contaminated by foreign
objects and can move smoothly.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT AND CLEAN
THROTTLE BODY
ES
ES–348
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2111
Throttle Actuator Control System - Stuck Open
DTC
P2112
Throttle Actuator Control System - Stuck
Closed
DESCRIPTION
The throttle actuator is operated by the ECM, and it opens and closes the throttle valve using gears. The
opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor, which is mounted on the
throttle body. The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM to control the throttle actuator
and set the throttle valve angle in response to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
ES
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
P2111
ECM tries to close throttle valve but throttle position is
stuck
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Throttle actuator
Throttle body
Throttle valve
P2112
ECM tries to open throttle valve but throttle position is
stuck
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Throttle actuator
Throttle body
Throttle valve
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the ETCS when the throttle valve remains at a fixed
angle despite a high drive current from the ECM. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2111: Throttle actuator stuck open
P2112: Throttle actuator stuck closed
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Throttle actuator motor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
P2111:
System guard*
ON
Throttle actuator current
2 A or more
Duty cycle to close throttle
80 % or more
*: System guard is ON when the following conditions are met
-
Throttle actuator
ON
Throttle actuator duty calculation
Executing
Throttle position sensor
Fail determined
Throttle actuator current-cut operation
Not executing
Throttle actuator power supply
4 V or more
Throttle actuator
Fail determined
ES–349
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P2112:
System guard*
ON
Throttle actuator current
2 A or more
Duty cycle to open throttle
80 % or more
*: System guard is ON when the following conditions are met
-
Throttle actuator
ON
Throttle actuator duty calculation
Executing
Throttle position sensor
Fail determined
Throttle actuator current-cut operation
Not executing
Throttle actuator power supply
4 V or more
Throttle actuator
Fail determined
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TP sensor voltage change
ES
No change
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 7°throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned OFF.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 (See page ES-341).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2111 OR P2112)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2111 or P2112
A
P2111 or P2112 and other DTCs
B
ES–350
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2111 or P2112 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK THROTTLE BODY (VISUALLY CHECK THROTTLE VALVE)
(a) Check for foreign matter between the throttle valve and
housing. If necessary, clean the throttle body.
Also, check that the throttle valve moves smoothly.
OK:
No foreign matter between the throttle valve and
the housing, and throttle valve can move smoothly.
ES
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
OK
3
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2111 OR P2112)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Clear the DTC (See page ES-35).
(d) Start the engine, and depress and release the
accelerator pedal quickly (fully open and close the
throttle valve).
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(f) Read DTC.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No DTC
A
P2111 and/or P2112
B
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–351
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2118
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Current Range
/ Performance
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a dedicated power supply circuit. The voltage (+BM)
is monitored and when the voltage is low (less than 4 V), the ECM concludes that the ETCS has a fault
and current to the throttle actuator is cut.
When the voltage becomes unstable, the ETCS itself becomes unstable. For this reason, when the
voltage is low, the current to the throttle actuator is cut. If repairs are made and the system has returned to
normal, turn the ignition switch OFF. The ECM then allows current to flow to the throttle actuator so that
the engine can be restarted.
HINT:
The ETCS does not use a throttle cable.
ES
ECM
ETCS
From
Battery
+BM
+M
Throttle Actuator
Control Circuit
-M
Throttle Actuator
ME01
A115751E01
DTC No.
P2118
DTC Detection Condition
Open in ETCS power source (+BM) circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ETCS fuse
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the battery supply voltage applied to the electronic throttle motor +BM. When the
power supply voltage drops below the threshold, the ECM concludes that the power supply has an open
circuit.
The MIL is turned on and a DTC is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2118: Throttle actuator power supply
Required Sensors/Components
Throttle actuator, throttle valve, ETCS fuse
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.8 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
ES–352
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Actuator power
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Throttle actuator power supply voltage (+BM)
Less than 4 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ES
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
9 to 14 V
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 16° throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned OFF.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
GR
2
2
13
IC4
GR
7
+BM
E8
Engine
Room R/B
ETCS
1
2
B
Battery
A074728E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–353
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
INSPECT FUSE (ETCS)
Engine
Room R/B:
ETCS Fuse
(a) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the ETCS fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
NG
REPLACE FUSE
A072882E03
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (+BM VOLTAGE)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / +BM.
Standard voltage:
9 to 14 V
OK
NG
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–354
3
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - ETCS FUSE, ETCS FUSE - BATTERY)
Engine Room R/B:
ETCS Fuse
ES
E8
(a) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector between the ETCS fuse and ECM.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine Room R/B (ETCS fuse
terminal 2) - +BM (E8-7)
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room R/B (ETCS fuse
terminal 2) or +BM (E8-7) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Disconnect the battery positive terminal.
(e) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector between the ETCS fuse and battery.
Standard resistance
+BM
A139336E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine Room R/B (ECTS fuse
terminal 1) - Battery positive terminal
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room R/B (ETCS fuse
terminal 1) or Battery positive
terminal - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(f) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(g) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–355
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
Throttle Actuator Control Throttle Body Range /
Performance
P2119
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) is composed of the throttle actuator that operates the
throttle valve, the throttle position sensor that detects the opening angle of the throttle valve, the
accelerator pedal position sensor that detects the accelerator pedal position, and the ECM that controls
the ETCS system.
The ECM operates the throttle actuator to position the throttle valve for proper response to driver inputs.
The throttle position sensor detects the opening angle of the throttle valve and provides this signal to the
ECM so that the ECM can regulate the throttle actuator.
DTC No.
P2119
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Throttle opening angle continues to vary greatly from
target throttle opening angle (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
ETCS
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the "actual" throttle angle based on the throttle position sensor signal. The "actual"
throttle position is compared to the "target" throttle position commanded by the ECM. If the difference of
these 2 values exceeds a specified limit, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ETCS system. The ECM
turns on the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2119: ETCS malfunction
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Throttle actuator motor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever following DTCs are not present
None
System guard*
ON
*System guard is ON when the following conditions set
-
Throttle actuator
ON
Throttle actuator duty calculation
Executing
TP sensor
Fail determined
Throttle actuator current-cut operation
Not executing
Throttle actuator power supply
4 V or higher
Throttle actuator
Fail determined
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of following conditions A or B is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Commanded closed TP - current closed TP
0.3 V or more
2. Commanded open TP - current open TP
0.3 V or more
ES
ES–356
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE
When any of these DTCs, as well as other DTCs relating to Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS)
malfunctions, are set, the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe mode, the ECM cuts the current to
the throttle actuator off, and the throttle valve is returned to a 16°throttle angle by the return spring. The
ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition
timing, in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle, to allow the vehicle to continue at a
minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and gently, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
Fail-safe mode continues until a pass condition is detected, and the ignition switch is then turned OFF.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 (See page ES-341).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2119)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2119
A
P2119 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2119 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2119)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM
[A].
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON [B].
(c) Turn the tester ON [C].
(d) Clear DTCS [D].
(e) Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds [E].
NOTICE:
Exercise extreme care and take precautions at steps
[F] and [G] below. Failure to do so may result in the
vehicle unexpectedly rolling away.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–357
(f)
Securely apply the parking brake and move the gear
selector lever to the D position [F].
(g) While depressing the brake pedal securely, fully depress
the accelerator pedal for 5 seconds [G].
(h) On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES
[H].
(i) Read DTCs [I].
HINT:
The output voltage of the throttle position sensor can be
checked during step [G] using the intelligent tester.
Variations in the output voltage indicate that the throttle
actuator is in operation. To check the output voltage
using the intelligent tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST /
PRIMARY / THROTTLE POS #1.
OK:
No DTC output.
NG
OK
NORMAL
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
ES
ES–358
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit
DTC
P2122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P2123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2125
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit
DTC
P2127
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P2128
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2138
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D" /
"E" Voltage Correlation
ES
HINT:
These DTCs relate to the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• This accelerator pedal position sensor is a non - contact type.
• This ETCS (Electronic Throttle Control System) does not use a throttle cable.
The Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket and has 2
sensor circuits: VPA1 (main) and VPA2 (sub). The voltage, which is applied to terminals VPA1 and VPA2
of the ECM, varies between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the operating angle of the accelerator pedal
(throttle valve). A signal from VPA1 indicates the actual accelerator pedal opening angle (throttle valve
opening angle) and is used for engine control. A signal from VPA2 conveys the status of the VPA1 circuit
and is used to check the APP sensor itself.
The ECM monitors the actual accelerator pedal opening angle (throttle valve opening angle) through the
signals from VPA1 and VPA2, and controls the throttle actuator according to these signals.
ES–359
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
Magnet
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Output Voltage (V)
ECM
*1
IC No.1
*2
VPA
EPA
5
3.7 to 4.4
VCPA
2.9 to 3.6
ES
VPA2
EPA2
1.6
1.4
VCP2
25
IC No.2
0
Usable Range
Accelerator Pedal Turning Angle(deg)
Magnet
*1 : Accelerator Pedal Fully Released
*2 : Accelerator Pedal Fully Depressed
A115889E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2120
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 second or more:
(a) VPA is 0.4 V or less when accelerator pedal is fully
released, or VPA is 4.8 V or more
•
•
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor
ECM
P2122
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 second or more when
accelerator pedal is fully released:
(a) VPA is 0.4 V or less
•
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in VCPA circuit
Open or ground short in VPA circuit
ECM
P2123
Condition (a) continues for 2.0 seconds or more:
(a) VPA is 4.8 V or more
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in EPA circuit
ECM
P2125
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 second or more:
(a) (VPA2 is 1.2 V or less when accelerator pedal is fully
released) or (VPA2 is 4.8 V or more and VPA is between 0.4 V
and 3.45 V)
•
•
APP sensor
ECM
P2127
VPA2 1.2 V or less for 0.5 seconds or more when accelerator
pedal fully released
•
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in VCP2 circuit
Open or ground short in VPA2 circuit
ECM
P2128
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 seconds or more
(a) VPA2 4.8 V or more
(b) VPA between 0.4 V and 3.45 V
•
•
•
APP sensor
Open in EPA2 circuit
ECM
P2138
Condition (a) or (b) continues for 2.0 seconds or more
(a) Difference between VPA and VPA2 0.02 V or less
(b) VPA1 0.4 V or less and VPA2 1.2 V or less
•
•
•
Short between VPA and VPA2 circuits
APP sensor
ECM
ES–360
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and P2138, use the intelligent tester
or the OBD II scan tool to confirm the throttle valve opening percentage.
Accelerator pedal position expressed as voltage
Trouble Area
ES
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal depressed
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
VC circuit open
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
VPA circuit open or ground
short
0 to 0.2 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
0 to 0.2 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
VPA2 circuit open or
ground short
0.5 to 1.1 V
0 to 0.2 V
2.6 to 4.5 V
0 to 0.2 V
E2 circuit open
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
HINT:
• Accelerator pedal positions are expressed as voltages.
• AP stands for Accelerator Pedal.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When VPA or VPA2 deviates from the standard, or the difference between the voltage outputs of the two
sensors is less than threshold, the ECM concludes that there is a defect in the accelerator pedal position
sensor. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
When the voltage output of the VPA is below 0.2 V or exceeds 4.8 V.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2120: Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor 1 range check (fluctuating)
P2122: APP sensor 1 range check (low voltage)
P2123: APP sensor 1 range check (high voltage)
P2125: APP sensor 2 range check (fluctuating)
P2127: APP sensor 2 range check (low voltage)
P2128: APP sensor 2 range check (high voltage)
P2138: APP sensor range check (correlation)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
APP sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
2.0 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
None
Ignition switch
ON
Throttle actuator power
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2120:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA1 voltage when VPA2 voltage is 0.04 V or more
0.4 V or less
2. VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2122:
VPA1 voltage when VPA2 voltage is 0.04 V or more
0.4 V or less
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–361
P2123:
VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2125:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.04 V or more
1.2 V or less
2. VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.4 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2127:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 0.04 V or more
1.2 V or less
P2128:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 0.4 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2138:
Either of following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
Condition 1
-
Difference between VPA1 and VPA2 voltages
0.02 V or less
Condition 2
Condition (a) and (b)
(a) VPA1 voltage
0.4 V or less
(b) VPA2 voltage
1.2 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VPA1 voltage
0.4 to 4.8 V
VPA2 voltage
1.2 to 4.8 V
Difference between VPA1 and VPA2 voltages
More than 0.02 V
FAIL-SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has two (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in
either of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the two
sensor circuits and switches to limp mode. In limp mode, the remaining circuit is used to calculate the
accelerator pedal opening to allow the vehicle to continue driving.
If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed.
In this case, the throttle valve will remain closed as if the engine is idling.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
ES
ES–362
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A24
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
VPA1
EP1
VCP1
ES
VPA2
EP2
VCP2
ECM
6
W-R
34
IC4
W-R
18
VPA
E8
5
LG-B
29
IC4
LG-B
20
E8
4
B-Y
26
IC4
B-Y
EPA
26
VCPA
E8
3
R-B
31
IC4
R-B
19 VPA2
E8
2
V-W
8
IC3
V-W
21
E8
W-L
9
IC3
W-L
1
EPA2
27
VCP2
E8
A152660E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCEL POS #1 AND ACCEL POS #2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS / ACCEL POS #1 and
ACCEL POS #2.
(d) Read the values displayed on the tester.
Standard voltage
Accelerator Pedal
Depressed
Released
FI07052E06
OK
NG
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.5 to 2.9 V
Depressed
2.5 to 4.6 V
3.5 to 5.5 V
Go to step 5
ES–363
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A24 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor Connector
VCP2
VPA1
A24
Front View
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VPA1 (A24-6) - VPA (E8-18)
EP1 (A24-5) - EPA (E8-20)
EP2
VCP1 (A24-4) - VCPA (E8-26)
EP1
VPA2
ECM Connector
Below 1 Ω
VPA2 (A24-3) - VPA2 (E8-19)
VCP1
EP2 (A24-2) - EPA2 (E8-21)
E8
VCP2 (A24-1) - VCP2 (E8-27)
Standard resistance (Check for short)
VPA2
VPA
EPA2
EPA
VCP2
VCPA
A115719E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VPA1 (A24-6) or VPA (E8-18) - Body
ground
EP1 (A24-5) or EPA (E8-20) - Body
ground
VCP1 (A24-4) or VCPA (E8-26) - Body
ground
VPA2 (A24-3) or VPA2 (E8-19) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
EP2 (A24-2) or EPA2 (E8-21) - Body
ground
VCP2 (A24-1) or VCP2 (E8-27) - Body
ground
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–364
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
INSPECT ECM (VCPA AND VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the A24 APP sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage of the E8 ECM connector.
Standard voltage
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCPA (E8-26) - EPA (E8-20)
4.5 to 5.0 V
VCP2 (E8-27) - EPA2 (E8-21)
A24
(d) Reconnect the APP sensor connector.
NG
ES
VPA2
E8
REPLACE ECM
VPA
EPA2
ECM Connector
EPA
VCP2
VCPA
A138089E01
OK
4
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace accelerator pedal rod assembly (See page ES512).
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-35).
Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 or P2138
A
No output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–365
A
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–29
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
2UZ-FE SFI SYSTEM
Symptom
Engine does not crank (does not start)
No initial combustion (does not start)
No complete combustion (does not start)
Difficult to start (engine cranks normally)
Difficult to start (with cold engine)
Difficult to start (with hot engine)
High engine idle speed (poor idling)
Low engine idle speed (poor idling)
Rough idling (poor idling)
Hunting (poor idling)
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (Poor driveability)
Engine stalls during A/C operation
Suspected Area
See page
1. Cranking holding function circuit
ES-469
2. Starter
ST-12
3. Starter relay
ST-19
4. VC output circuit
ES-459
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-454
2. VC output circuit
ES-459
3. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
4. ECM
ES-510
Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
1. Starter signal circuit
ES-290
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
3. Compression
EM-3
1. Starter signal circuit
ES-290
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
1. Starter signal circuit
ES-290
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
1. A/C signal circuit (compressor circuit)
AC-82
2. ECM power source circuit
ES-454
1. A/C signal circuit (compressor circuit)
AC-82
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
1. Compression
EM-3
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-454
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-454
2. A/T faulty
-
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
AC-82
2. ECM
ES-510
Surging (Poor driveability)
Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
Unable to refuel/Difficult to refuel
ORVR system
-
Engine stalls soon after starting
Fuel pump control circuit
ES-463
ES
ES–30
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECM
1.
E4
7
6
5
4
ECM
E5
3
2
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
E6
2
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1
8
7
6
5
4
E7
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
6
5
4
E8
3
2
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1
8
7
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
27 26
25 24
23 22 21 20
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
25 24
23 22 21 20 19 18
34 33
35 34
33 32
31 30 29 28
32 31
35 34 33 32 31
31 30
29 28
32 31 30 29 28
30
29 28
30 29 28
27 26
ES
A121603E05
HINT:
The standard normal voltage between each pair of ECM
terminals is shown in the table below. The appropriate
conditions for checking each pair of terminals are also
indicated. The result of checks should be compared with
the standard normal voltage for that pair of terminals,
displayed in the STD Voltage column. The illustration
above can be used as a reference to identify the ECM
terminal locations.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
BATT (E8-3) - E1 (E6-1)
L - W-B
Battery (for measuring the
battery voltage and for the
ECM memory)
Always
9 to 14 V
+BM (E8-7) - E1 (E6-1)
GR - W-B
Power source of throttle
motor
Always
9 to 14 V
IGSW (E8-9) - E1 (E6-1)
B-O - W-B
+B (E8-1) - E1 (E6-1)
+B2 (E8-2) - E1 (E6-1)
Condition
STD Voltage
Ignition switch
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
B - W-B
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
B - W-B
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
EFI relay
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Power source for sensor
(specific voltage)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
Mass air flow meter
Idling, shift lever position P or N,
A/C switch OFF
0.5 to 3.0 V
MREL (E8-8) - E1 (E6-1)
W-G - W-B
VC (E4-23) - E2 (E4-28)
L-R - BR
VG (E4-30) - E2G (E4-29)
W-R - B-W
THA (E4-22) - E2 (E4-28)
Y-B - BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
Idling, Intake air temperature
20°C (68°F)
0.5 to 3.4 V
THW (E4-21) - E2 (E4-28)
R-L - BR
Engine coolant
temperature sensor
Idling, Engine coolant
temperature 80°C (176°F)
0.2 to 1.0 V
VTA1 (E4-20) - E2 (E4-28)
Y - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully closed
0.5 to 1.2 V
VTA1 (E4-20) - E2 (E4-28)
Y - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully open
3.2 to 4.8 V
VTA2 (E4-19) - E2 (E4-28)
R-B - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully open
2.1 to 3.1 V
VTA2 (E4-19) - E2 (E4-28)
R-B - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully open
4.5 to 5.5 V
ES–31
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
VPA (E8-18) - EPA (E820)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
W-R - LG-B
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully closed
Condition
STD Voltage
0.5 to 1.1 V
VPA (E8-18) - EPA (E820)
W-R - LG-B
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully open
2.6 to 4.5 V
VPA2 (E8-19) - EPA2 (E821)
R-B - V-W
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for sensor
malfunction detection)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully closed
1.2 to 2.0 V
OC1+ (E6-17) - OC1- (E616)
P - LG
Camshaft timing oil control
valve (OCV)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
OC2+ (E6-15) - OC2- (E614)
R-W - Y-R
Camshaft timing oil control
valve (OCV)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
VV1+ (E6-25) - VV1- (E624)
Y*1 - L*1
Variable valve timing
(VVT) sensor (Bank 1)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 4)
VV2+ (E6-18) - VV2- (E628)
R*1 - G*1
Variable valve timing
(VVT) sensor (Bank 2)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 4)
M+ (E4-5) - E1 (E6-1)
R*1 - W-B
Throttle motor
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 7)
M- (E4-4) - E1 (E6-1)
G*1 - W-B
Throttle motor
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 8)
A1A+ (E5-22) - E1 (E6-1)
Y*1 - W-B
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V*2
A1A- (E5-30) - E1 (E6-1)
BR*1 - W-B
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V*2
A2A+ (E5-23) - E1 (E6-1)
P*1 - W-B
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V*2
A2A- (E5-31) - E1 (E6-1)
L*1 - W-B
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V*2
HA1A (E5-2) - E1 (E6-1)
R-L - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Idling
HA1A (E5-2) - E1 (E6-1)
R-L - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Ignition switch ON
HA2A (E5-1) - E1 (E6-1)
B-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Idling
HA2A (E5-1) - E1 (E6-1)
B-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Ignition switch ON
VPA2 (E8-19) - EPA2 (E821)
R-B - V-W
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for sensor
malfunction detection)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve
fully open
3.4 to 5.3 V
VCPA (E8-26) - EPA (E820)
B-Y - LG-B
Power source of
accelerator pedal position
sensor (for VPA)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCP2 (E8-27) - EPA2 (E821)
W-L - V-W
Power source of
accelerator pedal position
sensor (for VPA2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
OX1B (E4-18) - E1 (E6-1)
B*1 - W-B
Heated oxygen sensor
Maintain engine speed at 2,500
rpm for 2 minutes after warming
up
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Idling
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Injector
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
OX2B (E5-33) - E1 (E6-1)
W*1 - W-B
HT1B (E4-1) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - W-B
HT2B (E5-5) - E1 (E6-1)
P - W-B
HT1B (E4-1) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - W-B
HT2B (E5-5) - E1 (E6-1)
P - W-B
#10 (E6-2) - E01 (E4-7)
R-L - W-B
#20 (E6-3) - E01 (E4-7)
L - W-B
#30 (E6-4) - E01 (E4-7)
W - W-B
#40 (E6-5) - E01 (E4-7)
Y - W-B
#50 (E6-6) - E01 (E4-7)
G - W-B
#60 (E6-7) - E01 (E4-7)
R - W-B
#70 (E4-3) - E01 (E4-7)
W - W-B
#80 (E4-2) - E01 (E4-7)
BR - W-B
Below 3.0 V
9 to 14 V
Below 3.0 V
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
(See waveform 10)
Below 3.0 V
ES
ES–32
Symbols (Terminal No.)
#10 (E6-2) - E01 (E4-7)
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage
R-L - W-B
#20 (E6-3) - E01 (E4-7)
L - W-B
#30 (E6-4) - E01 (E4-7)
W - W-B
#40 (E6-5) - E01 (E4-7)
Y - W-B
#50 (E6-6) - E01 (E4-7)
G - W-B
Injector
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
#60 (E6-7) - E01 (E4-7)
R - W-B
#70 (E4-3) - E01 (E4-7)
W - W-B
#80 (E4-2) - E01 (E4-7)
BR - W-B
KNK1 (E5-29) - EKNK
(E5-28)
G*1 - R*1
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000
rpm after warming up
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
KNK2 (E5-21) - EKN2 (E520)
W*1 - B*1
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000
rpm after warming up
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
G2+ (E6-19) - G2- (E6-29)
B-W
Camshaft position sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 5)
NE+ (E6-21) - NE- (E6-20)
L*1 - Y*1
Crankshaft position sensor Idling
Pulse generation
(See waveform 5)
PRG (E4-34) - E1 (E6-1)
Y-R - W-B
VSV for EVAP
Ignition switch ON
SPD (E7-8) - E1 (E6-1)
V-R - W-B
Speed signal from
combination meter
Ignition switch ON, Rotate driving
wheel slowly
G-R - W-B
Fuel pump relay
Ignition switch ON
0 to 3.0 V
Fuel pump control
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition signal)
Idling
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation
signal)
Ignition switch ON
Idling
FPR (E6-30) - E1 (E6-1)
FC (E8-10) - E1 (E6-1)
GR-B - W-B
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
(See waveform 6)
IGT1 (E4-8) - E1 (E6-1)
LG - W-B
IGT2 (E4-15) - E1 (E6-1)
LG-B - W-B
IGT3 (E4-11) - E1 (E6-1)
L-W - W-B
IGT4 (E4-10) - E1 (E6-1)
L-Y - W-B
IGT5 (E4-13) - E1 (E6-1)
B-L - W-B
IGT6 (E4-12) - E1 (E6-1)
G - W-B
IGT7 (E4-14) - E1 (E6-1)
G-W - W-B
IGT8 (E4-9) - E1 (E6-1)
G-B - W-B
IGF1 (E4-24) - E1 (E6-1)
R-Y - W-B
IGF2 (E4-25) - E1 (E6-1)
R-W - W-B
IGF1 (E4-24) - E1 (E6-1)
R-Y - W-B
IGF2 (E4-25) - E1 (E6-1)
R-W - W-B
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation
signal)
STP (E8-15) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - W-B
Stop light switch
Brake pedal depressed
7.5 to 14 V
STP (E8-15) - E1 (E6-1)
G-Y - W-B
Stop light switch
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
R-L - W-B
Stop light switch (opposite
to STP terminal)
Ignition switch ON, Brake pedal
depressed
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E8-16) - E1 (E6-1)
R-L - W-B
Stop light switch (opposite
to STP terminal)
Ignition switch ON, Brake pedal
released
7.5 to 14 V
STAR/NSW (E5-8) - E1
(E6-1)
P - W-B
Park/Neutral position
switch
Ignition switch ON, Shift lever
position other than P and N
9 to 14 V
STAR/NSW (E5-8) - E1
(E6-1)
P - W-B
Park/Neutral position
switch
Ignition switch ON, Shift lever
position in P, N
Below 3.0 V
Pulse generation
(See waveform 9)
4.5 to 5.5 V
Pulse generation
(See waveform 9)
W (E7-30) - E1 (E6-1)
R-B - W-B
MIL
Idling
W (E7-30) - E1 (E6-1)
R-B - W-B
MIL
Ignition switch ON
Below 3.0 V
9 to 14 V
ELS1 (E7-13) - E1 (E6-1)
G - W-B
Electric load
Taillight switch ON, Defogger
switch ON
7.5 to 14 V
ELS2 (E7-12) - E1 (E6-1)
Y-G - W-B
Electric load
Taillight switch OFF, Defogger
switch OFF
0 to 1.5 V
TACH (E7-1) - E1 (E6-1)
B-W - W-B
Engine speed
Idling
TC (E8-23) - E1 (E6-1)
P-L - W-B
Terminal TC of DLC3
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation
(See waveform 11)
9 to 14 V
ES–33
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage
STA (E6-11) - E1 (E6-1)
B-Y - W-B
Starter signal
Cranking
STA (E6-11) - E1 (E6-1)
B-Y - W-B
Park/neutral position
switch
Shift lever position P or N, Ignition
switch START
9 to 14 V
STSW (E6-12) - E1 (E6-1)
L-Y - W-B
STA No. 2 fuse
Shift lever position P or N, Ignition
switch START
9 to 14 V
VPMP (E8-5) - E1 (E6-1)
R-G - W-B
Canister closed valve
Ignition switch ON
9 V to 14 V
MPMP (E8-6) - E1 (E6-1)
O - W-B
Leak detection pump
Vacuum pump OFF
0 V to 3 V
MPMP (E8-6) - E1 (E6-1)
O - W-B
Leak detection pump
Vacuum pump ON
9 V to 14 V
PPMP (E8-22) - E1 (E6-1)
R - W-B
Vapor pressure sensor
Ignition switch ON
3 V to 3.6 V
AIV1 (E4-27) - E1 (E6-1)
P - W-B
VSV for air injection
control (Bank 1)
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
AIV2 (E4-26) - E1 (E6-1)
L - W-B
VSV for air injection
control (Bank 2)
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
AIRV (E8-4) - E1 (E6-1)
Y - W-B
AI driver (ASV control
signal)
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
G - W-B
AI driver (Air pump control
signal)
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Air pressure sensor
Ignition switch ON
3 V to 3.6 V
AIRP (E8-25) - E1 (E6-1)
AIP (E4-32) - E1 (E6-1)
W-L - W-B
6 V or higher
HINT:
• *1: Shielded
• *2: The ECM terminal voltage is constant regardless
of the output voltage from the sensor.
(a) WAVEFORM 1
Fuel injector
20 V/DIV.
ECM Terminal Names
Between #10 (to #40) and E01
Tester Range
20 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Idling
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as engine rpm
increases.
Ground
20 msec./DIV.
A093279E06
(b) WAVEFORM 2
Knock sensor
1 V/DIV.
GND
1 msec./DIV.
A085286E15
ECM Terminal Name
Between KNK1 and EKNK
Between KNK2 and EKN2
Tester Range
1 V/DIV., 1 msec./DIV.
Condition
Maintain engine RPM at 2,000 rpm after
engine warmed-up
HINT:
• The wavelength becomes shorter as engine rpm
increases.
• The waveforms and amplitudes displayed differ
slightly depending on the vehicle.
ES
ES–34
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) WAVEFORM 3
Camshaft timing oil control valve (OCV)
0.2 V/DIV.
ECM Terminal Name
A
Ground
B
Tester Range
0.2 V/DIV., 200 msec./DIV.
Condition
Accelerate slowly after engine warmedup
HINT:
In the DATA LIST, the items VVT OCV DUTY B1
and B2 show the duty ratio of voltage flowing to the
OCV (see illustration).
VVT OCV DUTY B1, B2 = A/B x 100 (%)
200 msec./DIV.
A093281E07
(d) WAVEFORM 4
Variable Valve Timing (VVT) sensor (bank 1, 2)
and Crankshaft position sensor
2 V/ DIV.
ES
Between OC1+ and OC1Between OC2+ and OC2-
CH1
Ground
CH2
Ground
CH3
Ground
ECM Terminal Name
20 msec./DIV.
Crank Angle
60°
Idle after engine warmed-up
ECM Terminal Name
60°
GND
120°
2 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
(e) WAVEFORM 5
Camshaft position sensor and Crankshaft
position sensor
2 V/DIV
120°
Tester Range
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as engine rpm
increases.
A085260E11
180°
CH1: Between VV1+ and VV1CH2: Between VV2+ and VV2CH3: Between NE+ and NE-
Between G2+ and G2-
Tester Range
2 V/DIV, 200 msec./DIV
Condition
Idle after engine warmed up
180°
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as the engine rpm
increases.
200 msec./DIV
A138873E01
(f)
5 V/DIV.
Ground
WAVEFORM 6
Vehicle speed signal
ECM Terminal Name
Between SPD2+ and SPD2-
Tester Range
5 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Driving by 40 km/h (25 mph)
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as engine rpm
increases.
10 msec./DIV.
A093224E18
ES–35
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(g) WAVEFORM 7
Throttle actuator positive terminal
5 V/DIV.
ECM Terminal Name
Between M+ and ME01
Tester Range
5 V/DIV., 1 msec./DIV.
Condition
Idle after engine warmed-up
HINT:
The duty ratio varies depending on the throttle
opening operation.
Ground
1 msec./DIV.
A093274E10
(h) WAVEFORM 8
Throttle actuator negative terminal
5 V/DIV.
ECM Terminal Name
Between M- and ME01
Tester Range
5 V/DIV., 1 msec./DIV.
Condition
Idle after engine warmed-up
HINT:
The duty ratio varies depending on the throttle
opening operation.
Ground
1 msec./DIV.
A093275E09
(i)
2 V/DIV.
WAVEFORM 9
Igniter IGT signal (from ECM to igniter) and
Igniter IGF signal (from igniter to ECM)
(a)
Ground
ECM Terminal Name
(a) Between IGT1 (to IGT8) and E1
(b) Between IGF1 (IGF2) and E1
Tester Range
2 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
(b)
Ground
Condition
Idling
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as engine rpm
increases.
20 msec./DIV.
A093278E14
(j)
0.2 V/DIV.
WAVEFORM 10
Heated oxygen (HO2) sensor
ECM Terminal Names
Ground
200 msec./DIV.
A088863E13
Between OX1B and E2
Tester Ranges
0.2 V/DIV., 200 msec./DIV.
Conditions
Engine speed maintained 2,500 rpm for
2 minutes after warming up sensor
HINT:
In the DATA LIST, item O2S B1S2 shows the ECM
input values from the heated oxygen sensor.
(k) WAVEFORM 11
Engine speed signal
5 V/DIV.
Ground
ECM Terminal Names
Between TACH and E1
Tester Range
5 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Idling
HINT:
The wavelength becomes shorter as engine rpm
increases.
10 msec./DIV.
A093225E07
ES
ES–366
DTC
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Range / Performance
P2121
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
This DTC relates to the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
Refer to DTC P2120 (See page ES-353).
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2121
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 0.5 second:
(a) Difference between VPA1 and VPA2 deviates from the
standard
(b) IDL is OFF
•
•
APP sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The accelerator pedal position sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket. The accelerator pedal
position sensor has 2 sensor elements / signal outputs: VPA1 and VPA2. VPA1 is used to detect the
actual accelerator pedal angle (used for engine control) and VPA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VPA1.
When the difference between the voltage outputs of VPA1 and VPA2 deviates from the standard, the ECM
concludes the accelerator pedal position sensor has a malfunction. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC
is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2121: Accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor rationality
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
APP sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
None
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Ignition switch
ON
2. Throttle actuator power
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between VPA1 voltage (learned value) and VPA2 voltage
(learned value)
Less than 0.4 V, or more than 1.2 V
FAIL-SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has two (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in
either of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the two
sensor circuits and switches to limp mode. In limp mode, the remaining circuit is used to calculate the
accelerator pedal opening to allow the vehicle to continue driving.
If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed.
In this case, the throttle valve will remain closed as if the engine is idling.
ES–367
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2120 (See page ES-357).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
ES
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2121)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2121
A
P2121 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2121 are output, troubleshoot
those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCEL POS#1 AND ACCEL POS#2)
Depressed
Released
FI07052E06
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS / ACCEL POS#1 and
ACCEL POS#2.
(d) Read the voltage for the accelerator pedal position
sensor data.
Standard voltage
Accelerator pedal
operations
ACCEL POS#1
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.5 to 2.9 V
Depressed
2.5 to 4.6 V
3.5 to 5.5 V
OK
ACCEL POS#2
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–368
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
3
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY
NEXT
4
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2121)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
ES
(f)
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2121
A
No output
B
B
A
REPLACE ECM
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-35).
Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Read DTCs.
Result
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–369
DTC
P2195
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Lean (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2196
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Rich (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2197
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Lean (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2198
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Rich (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• Although the DTC titles refer to the "oxygen sensor", these DTCs relate to the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted in front of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and
located near the engine assembly.
The A/F sensor generates voltage* that corresponds to the actual air fuel ratio. This sensor voltage is
used to provide the ECM with feedback so that it can control the air fuel ratio. The ECM determines the
deviation from the stoichiometric air fuel ratio level, and regulates the fuel injection time. If the A/F sensor
malfunctions, the ECM is unable to control the air fuel ratio accurately.
The A/F sensor is the planar type and is integrated with the heater, which heats the solid electrolyte
(zirconia element). This heater is controlled by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the exhaust
gas temperature is low), a current flows into the heater to heat the sensor, in order to facilitate accurate
oxygen concentration detection. In addition, the sensor and heater portions are narrower than the
conventional type. The heat generated by the heater is conducted to the solid electrolyte through the
alumina, and the sensor activation is accelerated.
In order to obtain a high purification rate of the carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and nitrogen
oxide (NOx) components in the exhaust gas, a TWC is used. For the most efficient use of the TWC, the air
fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric level.
HINT:
*: Value changes inside the ECM. Since the A/F sensor is the current output element, the current is
converted to a voltage inside the ECM. Any measurements taken at the A/F sensor or ECM connectors
will show a constant voltage.
ES
ES–370
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Alumina
Heater
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Element
Platinum Electrode
Cover
ES
Atmospheric Air
Exhaust Gas
A
A
Air Fuel Ratio
A-A Section
A107164E07
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
P2195
P2197
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor voltage more than 3.8 V
(b) Heated Oxygen (HO2) sensor voltage 0.15 V or more
P2195
P2197
While fuel-cut operation performed (during vehicle
deceleration), air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor current 3.6 mA or
more for 3 seconds (2 trip detection logic)
P2196
P2198
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) A/F sensor voltage less than 2.8 V
(b) HO2 sensor voltage less than 0.85 V
P2196
P2198
While fuel-cut operation performed (during vehicle
deceleration), air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor current less than
1.4 mA for 3 seconds (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank
1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
heater
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Fuel injector
ECM
•
•
A/F sensor
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) heater
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Fuel injector
ECM
•
•
A/F sensor
ECM
•
•
HINT:
• DTCs P2195 and P2196 indicate malfunctions related to bank 1 A/F sensor circuit.
• DTCs P2197 and P2198 indicate malfunctions related to bank 2 A/F sensor circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes No. 1 cylinder.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that includes No. 2 cylinder.
• When any of these DTCs are set, check the A/F sensor output voltage by entering the following menus
on the intelligent tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / AFS B1S1.
• Short-term fuel trim values can also be read using the intelligent tester.
ES–371
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• The ECM regulates the voltages at the A1A+, A2A+, A1A- and A2A- terminals of the ECM to a
constant level. Therefore, the A/F sensor output voltage cannot be confirmed without using the
intelligent tester.
• If an A/F sensor malfunction is detected, the ECM sets a DTC.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
• Sensor voltage detection monitor
Under the air fuel ratio feedback control, if the A/F sensor output voltage indicates rich or lean for a
certain period of time, the ECM determines that is a malfunction in the A/F sensor. The ECM
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
Example:
If the A/F sensor voltage output is less than 2.8 V (very rich condition) for 10 seconds, despite the HO2
sensor output voltage being less than 0.6 V, the ECM sets DTC P2196. Alternatively, if the A/F sensor
output voltage is more than 3.8 V (very lean condition) for 15 seconds, despite the HO2 sensor output
voltage being 0.15 V or more, DTC P2195 is set.
• Sensor current detection monitor:
A rich air-fuel mixture causes a low air-fuel ratio sensor current, and a lean air fuel mixture causes a
high air-fuel ratio sensor current. Therefore, the sensor output becomes high during acceleration, and
the sensor becomes low during deceleration.
The ECM monitors the air-fuel ratio sensor current during fuel-cut and detects unusual current value. If
the cumulative time sensor output exceeds 3 seconds, the ECM interprets a malfunction in the air-fuel
ratio sensor and sets a DTC.
Normal Condition:
Malfunction Condition:
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idling
(1) Idling
Engine RPM
(1) Idling
(1) Idling
Engine RPM
“Condition (3)” 0.76 V or More
A/F Sensor
A/F Sensor
Voltage
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
“Condition (1), (2)” Change
When A/F sensor circuit malfunctioning, voltage
at approximately 0.66 V
output does not change
A133737E01
ES
ES–372
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2195: A/F sensor (Bank 1) signal stuck lean
P2196: A/F sensor (Bank 1) signal stuck rich
P2197: A/F sensor (Bank 2) signal stuck lean
P2198: A/F sensor (Bank 2) signal stuck rich
Required Sensors/Components
A/F sensor
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
5 seconds: A/F sensor signal stuck lean/rich
3 seconds: A/F sensor current (high/low side)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
All
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 (O2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0136, P0156 (O2 Sensor - Sensor 2)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0308 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0455, P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
P2440 (AIR control valve stuck open)
P2441 (AIR control valve stuck close)
P2444 (AIP stuck ON)
P2445 (AIP stuck OFF)
Sensor voltage detection monitor:
Time after engine start
30 seconds or more
Fuel system status
closed-loop
Sensor current detection monitor P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or higher
Air-fuel ratio sensor status
Activated
ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
Continuous time of fuel cut
3 to 10 seconds
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor voltage detection monitor (Lean side malfunction P2195, P2197):
A/F sensor voltage
More than 3.8 V
Rear HO2S voltage
Rises from less than 0.21 V to 0.59 V or more
Sensor voltage detection monitor (Rich side malfunction P2196, P2198):
A/F sensor voltage
Less than 2.8 V
Rear HO2S voltage
Falls from 0.59 V or more to less than 0.21 V
Sensor current detection monitor (High side malfunction P2195, P2197):
Air-fuel ratio sensor current
3.6 mA or more
Sensor current detection monitor (Rich side malfunction P2196, P2198):
Air-fuel ratio sensor current
Less than 1.4 mA
ES–373
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR RESULT
Detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
35
IC4
W-G
8
E8 MREL
W-G
A12
A/F Sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
ES
(*1)
B
W
2
+B AF-
BR
4
30
E5 A1A-
B-R
2
2
3
2
1
5
1
EFI
Relay
5
2
Y
3
R-L
L
W-B
2
2
W
2
2
EFI
A/F
HTR
1
(*1)
W +B AF4
C 2
L
4
IM1
W
2
W
1
HT AF+
P
3
B-W
J/C
1
E5 HA2A
W-B
E
B
J2
J28
J/C
B J3
Battery
23
E5 A2A+
9
IC4
W-B
B J2
31
E5 A2A-
C
W
Engine
Room R/B
B
J26
J/C
W-B
1
2
E5 HA1A
2
C
B-R
22
E5 A1A+
A13
A/F Sensor (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
2
2
1
W
A/F
HTR
Relay
3
2
2
Engine
Room R/B
2
HT AF+
E
EB
W-B
ED
*1: Shielded
A130714E02
ES–374
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
This confirmation driving pattern is used in the following diagnostic troubleshooting inspection procedure
when using the intelligent tester.
Monitor Drive Pattern
ECT: 70°C (158°F) or more
Vehicle Speed
Accelerator Pedal
Depressed
At least 3 times
Between 38 and 75 mph
(60 and 120 km/h)
[I]
40 mph (64 km/h)
or more
[G]
Accelerator Pedal
Released (Fuel-cut)
[J]
[K]
ES
[E]
Idling
6 mph
(10 km/h)
[H]
Warming up
10 seconds or 4 seconds or
more
more
10 minutes
or more
Time
Refer to figure below
A107162E20
Driving Pattern Detail for [H] through [K]
Cumulative Detection Period “t” = t1 + t2 + t3 = 3 seconds or more
Reference Engine RPM
Delay
Detection Period t1
[I]
[J]
[K]
2,500 rpm
1,000 rpm
Idling
t2
[H]
t3
Time
Idling
4 seconds
or more
4 seconds
or more
4 seconds
or more
A107163E13
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM [A].
Turn the ignition switch ON [B].
Turn the tester ON [C].
Clear DTCs (See page ES-35) [D].
Start the engine, and warm it up until the ECT reaches 75°C (167°F) or higher [E].
On the intelligent tester, enter the following menus to check the fuel-cut status: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / USER DATA / FC IDLE [F].
ES–375
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7. Drive the vehicle at between 38 mph (60 km/h) and 75 mph (120 km/h) for at least 10 minutes [G].
8. Change the transmission to 2nd gear [H].
9. Drive the vehicle at proper vehicle speed to perform fuel-cut operation [I].
HINT:
Fuel-cut is performed when the following conditions are met:
• Accelerator pedal fully released.
• Engine speed is 2,500 rpm or more (fuel injection returns at 1,000 rpm).
10.Accelerate the vehicle to 40 rpm (64 km/h) or more by depressing the accelerator pedal for at least 10
seconds [J].
11.Soon after performing step [J] above, release the accelerator pedal for at least 4 seconds without
depressing the brake pedal in order to execute fuel-cut control [K].
12.Allow the vehicle to decelerate until the vehicle speed declines to less than 6 mph (10 km/h) [L].
13.Repeat steps from [I] through [L] above at least 3 times in one driving cycle [M].
HINT:
Completion of all A/F sensor monitors is required to change the value in TEST RESULT.
CAUTION:
Strictly observe posted speed limits, traffic laws, and road conditions when performing these
drive patterns.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the intelligent tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST
/ A/F CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the output voltages of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection
volume by 25 %.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
ES
ES–376
Case
1
2
ES
3
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Areas
-
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, enter the following menus on the tester: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2. Then press the YES button and ENTER button, followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at
the time of a malfunction.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a rich air fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run rich.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a lean air fuel mixture. Check for conditions that
would cause the engine to run lean.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO P2195, P2196, 2197 OR P2198)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the tester ON
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
ES–377
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2195, P2196, P2197, or P2198
A
P2195, P2196, P2197, or P2198 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
are output, troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TEST VALUE OF A/F SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Clear DTCs (See page ES-35).
Allow the vehicle to drive in accordance with the drive
pattern described in the CONFIRMATION DRIVING
PATTERN.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / MONITOR INFO / MONITOR STATUS.
(f) Check the the status of O2S MON is COMPL.
If the status is still INCMPL, drive the vehicle according
to the driving pattern again.
HINT:
• AVAIL indicates that the component has not been
monitored yet.
• COMPL indicates that the component is functioning
normally.
• INCMPL indicates that the component is malfunctioning.
(g) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / MONITOR INFO / TEST RESULT / RANGE
B1S1; then press the ENTER button.
(h) Check the test value of the A/F sensor output current
during fuel-cut.
Result
Test Value
Proceed to
Within normal range (1.4 mA or more, and less than 3.6 mA)
A
Outside normal range (Less than 1.4 mA, or 3.6 mA or more)
B
B
Go to step 20
A
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Start the engine.
Turn the tester ON.
Warm up the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor at an engine
speed of 2,500 rpm for 90 seconds.
ES
ES–378
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(e) On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT / MANUAL
SNAPSHOT / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
and ENGINE SPD.
(f) Check the A/F sensor voltage three times, when the
engine is in each of the following conditions:
Operation Steps
ES
Step
Condition
(1)
While idling (check for at least 30
seconds)
(2)
At an engine speed of approximately
2,500 rpm (without any sudden
changes in engine speed)
(3)
Raise the engine speed to 4,000 rpm
and then quickly release the accelerator
pedal so that the throttle valve is fully
closed.
Standard voltage
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage Variation
Reference
(1) and (2)
Changes at approximately 0.66 V
Between 0.62 and 0.7 V
(3)
Increases to 0.76 V or more
This occurs during engine deceleration
(when fuel-cut performed)
HINT:
• For more information, see the diagrams below.
Malfunction Condition:
Normal Condition:
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idling
(1) Idling
(1) Idling
Engine RPM
Engine RPM
A/F Sensor
Voltage
A/F Sensor
Voltage
Fuel-cut
Fuel-cut
“Condition (1), (2)” Change at
approximately 0.66 V
(1) Idling
“Condition (3)”
0.76 V or more
When A/F sensor circuit malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A107161E13
• If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
approximately 0.66 V (see Malfunction Condition
diagram) under any conditions, including those
above, the A/F sensor may have an open circuit (this
will also happen if the A/F sensor heater has an open
circuit).
ES–379
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
either approximately 0.76 V or more, or 0.56 V or less
(see Malfunction Condition diagram) under any
conditions, including those above, the A/F sensor
may have a short circuit.
• The ECM stops fuel injection (fuel cut) during engine
deceleration. This causes a lean condition and results
in a momentary increase in the A/F sensor output
voltage.
• The ECM must establish a closed throttle valve
position learning value to perform fuel cut. If the
battery terminal has been reconnected, the vehicle
must be driven over 10 mph (16 km/h) to allow the
ECM to learn the closed throttle valve position.
• When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below
0.56 V during fuel enrichment. For the vehicle, this
translates to a sudden increase in speed with the
accelerator pedal fully depressed when trying to
overtake another vehicle. The A/F sensor is
functioning normally.
• The A/F sensor is a current output element; therefore,
the current is converted into a voltage inside the
ECM. Measuring the voltage at the connectors of the
A/F sensor or ECM will show a constant voltage
result.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
4
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2195, P2196, P2197, or P2198
A
No output
B
B
A
Go to step 9
ES
ES–380
6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
7
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
ES
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2195, P2196, P2197, or P2198
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
9
CONFIRM WHETHER VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
YES
DTC CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
10
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor
A12
A13
HT
+B
AF-
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 Ω to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
AF+
Front View
A085152E60
OK
Tester Connection
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
ES–381
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
11
INSPECT A/F RELAY
(a) Remove the A/F relay from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the A/F relay.
NG
REPLACE A/F RELAY
ES
OK
12
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A12
HT
+B
AF-
ECM Connector
E5
HA1A
HA2A
A2A+
A1A+
A2A-
A1A-
Specified Condition
Between 9 V and 14 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
(e) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(f) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
A13
AF+
Tester Connection
+B (2) - Body ground
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
Below 1 Ω
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A121613E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body
ground
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body
ground
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body
ground
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–382
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
A/F HEATER
A/F Sensor
ECM
A/F Heater Fuse
Heater
+B
From
Battery
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
Sensor
AF-
A1A-
ES
Duty
Control
From EFI Relay
A118002E16
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
13
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check the air induction system for vacuum leakage.
OK:
No leakage from air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
14
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the fuel pressure (See page FU-6).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
15
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR
(a) Check the injector injection (whether fuel volume is high
or low, and whether injection pattern is poor).
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR
ES–383
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
16
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
17
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
18
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
19
CONFIRM WHETHER VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
YES
DTC CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
20
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
21
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
22
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 OR P2198)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
ES
ES–384
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198 (A/F sensor pending DTCs)
B
B
A
ES
END
REPLACE ECM
ES–490
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ES
ENGINE UNDER COVER
ASSEMBLY REAR
29 (296, 21)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119814E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–491
ES
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
6.5 (65, 58 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119819E02
ES–385
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2237
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit /
Open (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2238
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2239
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2240
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit /
Open (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2241
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2242
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2252
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2253
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2255
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2256
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
High (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• Although the DTC titles refer to the "oxygen sensor", these DTCs relate to the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F)
sensor.
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted in front of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and is
located near the engine assembly.
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-364).
DTC No.
P2237
P2238
DTC Detection Condition
Open in the circuit between terminals AF+ and AF- of the
A/F sensor while engine is running
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
ES
ES–386
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
P2238
P2241
•
Case 1:
Condition (a) or (b) continues for 5.0 seconds or more
(1 trip detection logic):
(a) AF+ voltage 0.5 V or less
(b) (AF+) - (AF-) = 0.1 V or less
Case 2:
A/F sensor admittance: Less than 0.0221/Ω
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P2239
P2242
AF+ voltage more than 4.5 V for 5.0 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
ES
P2252
P2255
AF- voltage 0.5 V or less for 5.0 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
P2253
P2256
AF- voltage more than 4.5 V for 5.0 seconds or more
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank
1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor
1)
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
HINT:
• DTCs P2238, P2239, P2252 and P2253 indicate malfunctions related to bank 1 A/F sensor circuit.
• DTCs P2241, P2242, P2255 and P2256 indicate malfunctions related to bank 2 A/F sensor circuit.
• Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes No. 1 cylinder.
• Bank 2 refers to the bank that includes No. 2 cylinder.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
These DTCs are output when there is an open or short in the A/F sensor circuit, or if A/F sensor output
drops.
To detect these problems, the voltage of the A/F sensor is monitored when turning the ignition switch to
the ON position, and the admittance (admittance is an electrical term that indicates the ease of flow of
current) is checked while driving. If the voltage of the A/F sensor is between 0.6 V and 4.5 V, it is
considered normal. If the voltage is outside of the specified range, or the admittance is less than the
standard value, the ECM will determine that there is a malfunction in the A/F sensor. If the same
malfunction is detected in the next driving cycle, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set..
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2237: A/F sensor (Bank 1) open circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) low impedance
P2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2239: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and +B
P2240: A/F sensor (Bank 2) open circuit between AF+ and AFP2241: A/F sensor (Bank 2) low impedance
P2241: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2241: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2242: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and +B
P2252: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF- and GND
P2253: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF- and +B
P2255: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF- and GND
P2256: A/F sensor (Bank 2) short circuit between AF- and +B
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
-
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
ES–387
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052: A/F sensor heater
P0100 - P0103: MAF sensor
P0110 - P0113: IAT sensor
P0115 - P0118, P0125: ECT sensor
P0120 - P0223, P2135: TP sensor
P0125: Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop
P0171, P0172: Fuel trim
P0300 - P0308: Misfire
P0335: CKP sensor
P0455, P0456: EVAP system
P0500: VSS
P2440: AIR control valve stuck open
P2441: AIR control valve stuck close
P2444: AIP stuck On
P2445: AIP stuck Off
A/F sensor - Open circuit between AF+ and AFBattery voltage
13.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Estimated sensor temperature
450 to 550°C (842 to 1022°F) for P2237 and P2240
A/F sensor - Low impedance
Engine coolant temperature
0°C (0°F) or higher [Closed loop enabling ECT]
Estimated sensor temperature
700 to 800°C (1292 to 1472°F) for P2238 and P2241
Fuel cut
Not executed
Others:
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Time after ignition switch is OFF to ON
5 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2237 and P2240:
A/F sensor admittance
Below 0.002 1/Ω
P2238 and P2241:
When one of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1, 2 or 3
1. Sensor admittance
Less then 0.022 1/Ω
2. AF+ voltage
0.5 V or less
3. Difference of AF+ and AF-
Less than 0.1 V
P2239 and P2242:
AF+ terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
P2252 and P2255:
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2253 and P2256:
AF- terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
ES
ES–388
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Sensor admittance
0.022 1/Ω or more
AF+ voltage
0.6 to 4.5 V
AF- voltage
0.6 to 4.5 V
Difference of AF+ and AF-
0.11 to 0.8 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-368).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the output voltages of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and
O2S B2S2) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection
volume by 25 %.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard voltage
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 or AFS B2S1
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 or O2S B2S2
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
ES–389
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Case
1
2
3
4
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Areas
-
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
ES
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check and graph the output voltages of
both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2. Then press
the YES button and ENTER button, followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–390
1
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A12
HT
+B
AF+
AF-
A13
ECM Connector
A2A+
A1A+
A2A-
A1A-
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connections
Specified Conditions
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body
ground
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body
ground
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
E5
HA2A
Specified Conditions
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ES
HA1A
Tester Connections
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
A121613E02
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
A/F HEATER
A/F Sensor
ECM
A/F Heater Fuse
From
Battery
Heater
+B
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
Sensor
AF-
A1A-
Duty
Control
From EFI Relay
A118002E16
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–391
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
3
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
tester ON.
(c) Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35)
(d) Start the engine.
(e) Allow the engine to idle for 5 minutes or more.
(f) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
(g) Read pending DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2237, P2238, P2239, P2240, P2241, P2242, P2252, P2253, P2255
or P2256
B
B
A
END
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–392
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2401
Evaporative Emission Leak Detection Pump
Stuck OFF
DTC
P2402
Evaporative Emission Leak Detection Pump
Stuck ON
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
Monitoring Item
Malfunction
Detection Condition
Leak detection pump
stuck OFF
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure through
reference orifice, and
EVAP system
pressure measured
to determine leak
criterion.
Reference leak
pressure standard is
measured at the start
and at the end of the
leak check.
If system pressure
higher than -1.06 kPa
(-7.93 mmHg)*, or
lower than -4.85 kPa
(-36.38 mmHg)*,
ECM determines that
leak detection pump
stuck OFF.
ES
P2401
P2402
Leak detection pump
stuck ON
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure through
reference orifice, and
EVAP system
pressure measured
to determine leak
criterion.
If system pressure
higher than -1.06 kPa
(-7.93 mmHg)*, or
lower than -4.85 kPa
(-36.38 mmHg)*,
ECM determines that
leak detection pump
stuck ON.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
Canister pump
module
(reference orifice,
leak detection
pump, vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (canister
pump module ECM)
ECM
Ignition switch OFF
2 trip
Canister pump
module
(reference orifice,
leak detection
pump, vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (canister
pump module ECM)
ECM
Ignition switch OFF
2 trip
*: The threshold values vary according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described in the table above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg).
HINT:
The leak detection pump is built into the canister pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system (See page ES-425).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP system (See page ES-430).
ES–393
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned
OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Description
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after ignition switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operation
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES
ES–394
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation B, E:
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Criterion Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
OFF (vent)
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
ES
Reference Orifice (0.02 Inch)
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON (closed)
OFF
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
ON (closed)
Negative
Pressure
ON
ON
A112612E05
ES–395
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P2401: Leak detection pump stuck OFF
In operation B, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the reference
orifice. The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to
determine the 0.02 inch leak criterion. If the pressure is higher than -1.06 kPa (-7.95 mmHg)* or lower
than -4.85 kPa (-36.38 mmHg)*, the ECM interprets this as the leak detection pump being stuck OFF
(not operating). The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Leak Detection Pump Stuck OFF
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
OK
Sequence
A
B
C
D
E
Time (Second)
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106064E08
2. P2402: Vacuum pump stuck ON
In operation B, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the reference orifice.
The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to
determine the 0.02 inch leak criterion. If the pressure is higher than -1.06 kPa (-7.95 mmHg)* or lower
than -4.85 kPa (-36.38 mmHg)*, the ECM interprets this as the vacuum pump being stuck ON
(operating all the time). The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described above are based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
HINT:
The detection logic of DTCs P2401 and P2402 is the same because in both cases the 0.02 inch leak
criterion measured in operation B is compared to the atmospheric pressure registered in operation A.
The ECM calculates the difference between these pressures by deducting [the 0.02 inch leak criterion]
from [the stored atmospheric pressure], and uses this to monitor the EVAP system pressure change.
ES
ES–396
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
EVAP Pressure When Leak Detection Pump Stuck ON
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
ES
Negative
Malfunction
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Sequence
Time (Second)
A
B
C
D
E
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106065E07
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2401: Vacuum pump stuck OFF
P2402: Vacuum pump stuck ON
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 2 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–397
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
"Saturated" indicates that the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) in 30 seconds.
One of the following conditions set
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement start
-1 kPa (7.5 mmHg) or higher
2. Reference pressure
Less than -4.85 kPa (726 mmHg)
3. Reference pressure
-1.05 kPa (754 mmHg) or higher
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated
5. Difference between first reference pressure and second reference
pressure
0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg) or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
ES
ES–398
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2419
Evaporative Emission Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck ON
DTC
P2420
Evaporative Emission Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck OFF
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
Monitoring Items
ES
P2419
P2420
Vent valve stuck
closed
Vent valve stuck
open (vent)
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Vacuum pump
creates negative
pressure through
0.02 inch orifice and
EVAP system
pressure measured
to determine leak
pressure standard.
If system pressure
higher than -1.06 kPa
(-7.95 mmHg)* 4
seconds after
vacuum pump turned
ON, ECM determines
that vent valve stuck
closed.
Vacuum pump
creates negative
pressure through
0.02 inch orifice and
EVAP system
pressure measured
to determine leak
pressure standard.
0.02 inch leak
pressure standard is
measured at the start
and at the end of the
leak check.
If system pressure
does not increase by
more than 0.3 kPa
(2.25 mmHg) within
10 seconds when
vent valve turned ON,
ECM determines that
vent valve stuck
closed.
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Ignition switch OFF
2 trip
Pump module
Connector / Wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
ECM
Ignition switch OFF
2 trip
*: The threshold valve varies according to the atmospheric presser measured in operation A. The value
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
HINT:
The vent value is built into the pump module.
DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system (See page ES-425).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP system (See page ES-430).
ES–399
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned
OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after ignition switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
(reference pressure)
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operations
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES
ES–400
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation B, E:
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
0.02 Inch Leak Criterion Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
OFF (vent)
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
ES
Reference Orifice (0.02 Inch)
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON (closed)
OFF
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
ON (closed)
Negative
Pressure
ON
ON
A112612E05
ES–401
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P2419: Vent valve stuck closed
In operation B, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the reference
orifice. The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to
determine the 0.02 inch leak criterion. If the pressure exceeds -1.06 kPa (-7.95 mmHg)* 4 seconds
after the leak detection pump is turned ON, the ECM interprets this as the vent valve being stuck
closed. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
*: The threshold varies according to the atmospheric pressure measured in operation A. The values
described above is based on an atmospheric pressure of 100 kPa (750.1 mmHg): absolute pressure.
EVAP Pressure when Vent Valve Stuck OFF:
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
OK
4 seconds
Sequence
A
B
C
D
E
Time (Second)
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106066E03
ES
ES–402
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P2420: Vent valve stuck open (vent)
In operation C, the vent valve turns ON (closes) and the EVAP system pressure is then measured by
the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to conduct an EVAP leak check. If pressure does not drop
when the vent valve is open, the ECM interprets this as the vent valve being stuck open. The ECM
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
EVAP Pressure when Vent Valve Stuck OFF:
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ES
ON: Closed
ON
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Malfunction
Sequence
Time (Second)
A
B
C
D
E
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106067E03
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
2 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 2.5 mph (4 km/h)
Ignition switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
EVAP canister purge valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP canister vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Both of the following condition are met before key off
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–403
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
1. P2419: Vent valve stuck closed
"Saturated" indicates that the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) in 30 seconds.
One of following conditions set
-
1. EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement start
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or higher
2. Reference pressure
Less than -4.85 kPa (726 mmHg)
3. Reference pressure
-1.05 kPa (-7.93 mmHg) or higher
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated
5. Difference between first reference pressure and second reference
pressure
0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg) or more
2. P2420: Vent valve stuck open (vent)
EVAP pressure change after EVAP canister vent valve is ON
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
ES
ES–404
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P2430
Secondary Air Injection System Air Flow / Pressure Sensor Circuit Bank1
DTC
P2431
Secondary Air Injection System Air Flow / Pressure Sensor Circuit Range / Performance
Bank1
DTC
P2432
Secondary Air Injection System Air Flow / Pressure Sensor Circuit Low Bank1
DTC
P2433
Secondary Air Injection System Air Flow / Pressure Sensor Circuit High Bank1
DTC
ES
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2430
While the engine is running, if voltage output of the pressure
sensor indicates 0.1V or less, or indicates 4.8 V or more.
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Pressure sensor
Open or short in pressure sensor circuit
ECM
P2431
The pressure sensor indicates less than 45 kPa (338 mHg), or
more than 135 kPa (1013 mHg).
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Pressure sensor
Open or short in pressure sensor circuit
ECM
P2432
While the engine is running, if voltage output of pressure
sensor remains below 0.1 V.
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Pressure sensor
Open or short in pressure sensor circuit
ECM
P2433
While the engine is running, if voltage output of the pressure
sensor remains above 4.8 V.
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Pressure sensor
Open or short in pressure sensor circuit
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM observes the pressure in the secondary air passage using the pressure sensor located on the
air switching valve in the secondary air injection system.
If there is a defect in the sensor or the sensor circuit, the voltage level will deviate from the normal
operating range, the ECM interprets this deviation as a defect in the pressure sensor circuit and sets a
DTC.
Pressure Sensor
VC
AIP
E2
ECM
VC
3
23
2
32
1
28
AIP
E2
A115345E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–405
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2430: Air flow/pressure sensor circuit range check (Fluctuating)
P2431: Air flow/pressure sensor circuit rationality
P2432: Air flow/Pressure sensor circuit range check (Low voltage)
P2433: Air flow/pressure sensor circuit range check (High voltage)
Required sensors/Components
Pressure sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
P2430, P2432, P2433: 0.5 second
P2431: 5 second
MIL operation
P2430, P2432, P2433: Immediate
P2431: 2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
None
Starter
OFF
Time after starter turned from ON to OFF
2 seconds or more
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2430:
Air pressure sensor voltage
Less than 0.1 V, or more than 4.8 V
P2431:
Air pressure
Less than 45 kPa (338 mmHg), or more than 135 kPa (1013 mmHg)
P2432:
Air pressure sensor voltage
Less than 0.1 V
P2433:
Air pressure sensor voltage
More than 4.8 V
ES–406
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A45
Air Pressure Sensor
ECM
5V
VC
AIP
3
L-R
3
EB2
2
W-L
1
EB2
W-L
4
EB2
BR
ES
E2
1
BR
L-R
23 VC
E4
32
E4
AIP
28
E2
E4
A115928E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
ES–407
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Sensor Connector
AIP
Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
Disconnect the A45 pressure sensor connector.
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
A45
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VC (A45-3) - VC (E4-23)
E2
E4
Front View
AIP (A45-2) - AIP (E4-32)
VC
Below 1 Ω
E2 (A45-1) - E2 (E4-28)
VC (A45-3) or VC (E4-23) - Body
ground
ECM Connector
AIP (A45-2) or AIP (E4-32) - Body
ground
NG
VC
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E2
AIP
A115720E02
OK
2
INSPECT PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Connect the pressure gauge to the pressure sensor as
shown in the illustration.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON (Do not start engine).
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / AIR PMP PRS (A).
(f) Check the pressure displayed on the intelligent tester
fluctuates when applying the pressure to the pressure
sensor with the pressure gauge.
OK:
Pressure fluctuates in response to the pressure
applied with pressure gauge.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE PRESSURE SENSOR
ES
ES–408
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2444
Secondary Air Injection System Pump Stuck
On Bank1
DTC
P2445
Secondary Air Injection System Pump Stuck
Off Bank1
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-214).
DTC No.
P2444
ES
P2445
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Air pump stuck ON.
The secondary air pressure is more than 5 kPa (38 mmHg)
despite the ECM ordering the air pump to turn off.
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
Short in air pump circuit
Air injection control driver (AID)
Pressure sensor
Open or short in pressure sensor circuit
ECM
Air pump stuck OFF or air injection volume is insufficient.
The amount of air flow is below the criteria.
(The secondary air pressure is less than specified value
despite the ECM ordering the air pump turn ON.)
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air pump fuse
Vacuum hose
Air pump assembly
Air injection control driver (AID)
Open in air pump circuit
Air injection system piping
Pressure sensor
Open or short in pressure sensor circuit
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
P2444:
The ECM observes the pressure in the secondary air passage using the pressure sensor located on the
air switching valve in the secondary air injection system. The sensor measures the pressure in the
secondary air passage and sends a signal to the ECM.
If the pressure level from the sensor exceeds a certain level despite the ECM turning off the air pump, the
ECM interprets this as a fault in the secondary air injection system and sets a DTC.
P2445:
The ECM calculates the amount of air flow within the secondary air system based on the output values of
the pressure sensor and mass air flow meter.
The ECM determines whether the amount of air flow is normal or not according to the calculated value.
When the amount of air flow is below the criteria, the ECM stores the DTC and illuminates the MIL.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
(Case 1) P2444 Air pump stuck ON
(Case 2) P2445 Air pump stuck OFF
(Case 3) P2445 Air insufficient
(Case 4) P2445 Air pressure sensor stuck
Required sensors/Components
AIR valve, AIR VSV bank 1, AIR VSV bank 2
Required sensors/Components
AIR pressure sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 20 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–409
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
This monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0010, P0020: VVT system
P0011: VVT System 1 - Advance
P0012: VVT System 1 - Retard
P0016, P0018: VVT System - Misalignment
P0021: VVT System 2 - Advance
P0022: VVT System 2 - Retard
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052: Front A/F sensor heater
P0100 - P0103: MAF sensor
P0110 - P0113: IAT sensor
P0115 - P0118: ECT sensor
P0120 - P0223, P2125: TP sensor
P0125: Closed loop
P0171 - P0175: Fuel trim
P0300 - P0308: Misfire
P0327 - P0333: Knock sensor
P0335: CKP sensor
P0340 - P0346: VVT sensor
P0351 - P0358: Igniter
P0445 - P0446: EVAP system
P0450 - P0453: EVAP press sensor
P0500: VSS
P2196, P2198: A/F sensor - rationality
P2237, P2240: A/F sensor - open
P2430 - P2433: AIR pressure sensor
P2A00, P2A03: A/F sensor - slow response
Air pressure sensor stuck
ECT at engine start
Lower than 5°C (41°F)
IAT at engine start
-15°C (5°F) or higher
Time that ECT is 80°C (176°F) or higher
10 to 60 minutes
Cumulative intake air amount
109 g/sec. or more
Monitor Sequence 3
Completed
AIR valve
OFF
AIR valve bank 1
OFF
AIR valve bank 2
OFF
One of the following conditions is met
-
- Vehicle speed
80 km/h or more
- Engine RPM
0 rpm or more
- Throttle position
0° or more
Other:
Atmospheric pressure
45 kPa (420 mmHg) or more
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
AIR monitor runs in accordance with the monitor sequence 1 to 5
Monitor Sequence 1
Idle
ON
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
Either of following conditions 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
ON
-AIR valve bank 2
OFF
2. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
OFF
ES
ES–410
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
-AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 2
Idle
ON
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
AIR VSV bank 1
ON
AIR VSV bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 3
ES
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
ON
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
AIR valve bank 1
ON
AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 4-1
Runs when AIR pressure did not change at monitor sequence 2
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
ON
AIR valve
ON
Either of following conditions 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
ON
-AIR valve bank 2
OFF
2. Both of the following conditions are met
-
-AIR valve bank 1
OFF
-AIR valve bank 2
ON
Monitor Sequence 4-2
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
OFF
AIR VSV bank 1
OFF
AIR VSV bank 2
OFF
Monitor Sequence 5
Engine RPM
Less than 3,750 rpm
AIR status
OFF
AIR pump
OFF
AIR valve
ON
AIR VSV bank 1
OFF
AIR VSV bank 2
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2444 AIR pump ON stuck
AIR pressure during AIR OFF
5 kPa or more
P2445 AIR pump OFF stuck
AIR pressure during AIR ON
Less than 1 kPa
ES–411
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P2445 AIR insufficient
AIR amount
100 L/min. or less
P2445 AIR pressure sensor stuck
AIR pressure change
5 kPa or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0412 (See page ES-217).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine was
warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the time of
a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2444 AND P2445)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED
OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2445
A
P2444
B
P2444 and P2445
"P2444 and P2445" and other DTCs
C
HINT:
If any other codes besides P2444 or P2445 is output,
perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
C
A
Go to step 7
GO TO DTC CHART
ES
ES–412
2
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK AIR INJECTION SYSTEM PRESSURE
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
AIR INJ CHECK
AIR PUMP.....................ON
EASV.......................OPEN
ASV1.......................OPEN
ASV2.......................OPEN
A/F BANK1................OPEN
A/F BANK2..................14.5
PRESSURE..............17kPa
PULSATION.........25.39kPa
AISTATUS.....................OK
Remaining Time 05 sec.
Press [ EXIT ] to quit
A115721
ES
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(e) Start the engine.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
OPERATION / OPERATION 1 and 2.
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF, EASV: CLOSE, ASV1:
CLOSE, ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 2: AP: ON, EASV: OPEN, ASV1: OPEN,
ASV2: OPEN
(g) Check that the PRESSURE on the intelligent tester.
NOTICE:
This test only allows technicians to operate the AI
system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test can be
performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated,
intervals of at least 30 seconds are required between
tests.
While the AI system operation using the intelligent
tester is prohibited, the tester displays the
prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI STATUS
NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the engine for 10
minutes and then try again.
Standard pressure
Tester operation
Pressure
Operation 1
Less than 2.5 kPa
Operation 2
5 to 8 kPa or more
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35).
Start the engine.
Perform ACTIVE TEST to operate the air injection
system.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK /
AUTOMATIC OPERATION
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–413
(h) After operating the secondary air injection system,
confirm the pending codes for the secondary air injection
system by entering the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
(i) Read DTC and check DTC.
OK:
DTC P2444 or P2445 for the secondary air injection
system is not output.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
4
CHECK VACUUM HOSES
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Check the vacuum hose connection between the
pressure sensor and air switching valve.
OK:
The vacuum hose is securely connected.
(c) Inspect the vacuum hose for blockage and damage.
OK:
The vacuum hose has no blockage and damage.
Vacuum Hose
G032743E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
OK
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (AIR VOLTAGE)
Pressure Gauge
Pressure Sensor
G032742E01
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Connect the pressure gauge to the pressure sensor as
shown in the illustration.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON (Do not start engine).
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / AIR PMP PRS.
(f) Check that the pressure displayed on the intelligent
tester fluctuates when applying the pressure to the
pressure sensor with the pressure gauge.
OK:
Pressure fluctuates in response to the pressure
applied with pressure gauge.
NG
OK
REPLACE PRESSURE SENSOR
ES–414
6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK PIPING AND HOSES (CONNECTION OF ALL AIR INJECTION SYSTEM)
G032737E01
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Check that all the pipes and hoses between the air pump
and air switching valve are securely connected.
OK:
All air injection pipes and hoses are securely
connected.
(c) Check all pipes and hoses for blockages and damage.
OK:
All air injection pipes and hoses have no
blockages and damage.
NG
ES
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INJECTION
SYSTEM PIPING AND HOSES
OK
7
INSPECT AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER (POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
(a) Remove the intake manifold (See page ES-501).
(b) Disconnect the A44 Air Injection Control Driver (AID)
connectors.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Measure the voltage between terminals A44-5 (+B) and
A43-1 (BATT) of the AID and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A44
AID Connector
Tester Connection
+B (A44-5) - Body ground
E
A43
Front View
BATT (A43-1) - Body ground
+B
Specified Condition
10 V or more
(e) Measure the resistance between the terminal A44-1 (E)
of the AID and body ground.
Standard resistance
AID Connector
(f)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E (A44-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Reconnect the AID connector.
BATT
NG
Front View
A115722E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–415
INSPECT ECM (AIRP AND AIRV VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) When the air pump and air switching valve are operated
using the intelligent tester, measure voltage between
terminal E8-25 (AIRP) and E8-4 (AIRV) of the AID
connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
E8
AIRV
AIRP
E118245E25
Tester Connection
Air pump operation
Specified Condition
AIRP (E8-25) - Body
ground
ON
10 V or more
AIRP (E8-25) - Body
ground
OFF
3.5 to 7.7 V*
Tester Connection
Air switching valve
(ASV) operation (EASV)
Specified Condition
AIRV (E8-4) - Body
ground
OPEN
10 V or more
AIRV (E8-4) - Body
ground
CLOSE
3.5 to 7.7 V*
Standard voltage
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
OPERATION / OPERATION 1 and 2.
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF, EASV: CLOSE, ASV1:
CLOSE, ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 2: AP: ON, EASV: OPEN, ASV1: OPEN,
ASV2: OPEN
NOTICE:
This test only allows technicians to operate the AI
system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test can be
performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated,
intervals of at least 30 seconds are required between
tests.
While the AI system operation using the intelligent
tester is prohibited, the tester displays the
prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI STATUS
NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the engine for 10
minutes and then try again.
HINT:
*: 35 to 55 % of the +B voltage.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–416
9
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INJECTION CONTROL DRIVER - BODY
GROUND)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
Air Injection Driver Connector
A44
SIV
Front View
SIP
A115723E02
ES
Disconnect the A44 air injection driver connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
When the air pump and air switching valve are operated
using the intelligent tester, measure the voltage between
terminals A44-3 (SIV) and A44-4 (SIP) of the air injection
driver connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Air pump operation
Specified Condition
SIP (A44-4) - Body
ground
ON
10 V or more
SIP (A44-4) - Body
ground
OFF
3.5 to 7.7 V*
Tester Connection
ASV operation (EASV)
Specified Condition
SIV (A44-3) - Body
ground
OPEN
10 V or more
SIV (A44-3) - Body
ground
CLOSE
3.5 to 7.7 V*
Standard voltage
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL
OPERATION / OPERATION 1 and 2.
HINT:
OPERATION 1: AP: OFF, EASV: CLOSE, ASV1 :
CLOSE, ASV2: CLOSE
OPERATION 2: AP: ON, EASV: OPEN, ASV1: OPEN,
ASV2: OPEN
NOTICE:
This test only allows technicians to operate the AI
system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test can be
performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated,
intervals of at least 30 seconds are required between
tests.
While the AI system operation using the intelligent
tester is prohibited, the tester displays the
prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If the ERROR (AI
STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
*: 35 to 55 % of the +B voltage.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
10
ES–417
INSPECT AIR PUMP (OPERATION)
Pressure Gauge
Pressure Sensor
A115725E01
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the hose between EASV and ASV.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / AIR INJ CHECK / MANUAL /
OPERATION / OPERATION 2.
(e) When the air pump is operated, check that air comes out
from the air pump.
HINT:
OPERATION 2: AP: ON, EASV: CLOSE, ASV1: CLOSE,
ASV2: CLOSE
NOTICE:
• This test only allows technicians to operate the AI
system for 5 seconds. Furthermore, the test can
be performed 4 times a trip. If the test is repeated,
intervals of at least 30 seconds are required
between tests.
While the AI system operation using the
intelligent tester is prohibited, the tester displays
the prohibition (WAIT or ERROR). If ERROR (AI
STATUS NG) is displayed on the tester, stop the
engine for 10 minutes and then try again.
• When performing the AIR INJ CHECK operation
after the battery cable has been reconnected, wait
for 7 minutes with the ignition switch turned ON
or the engine running.
• Turn the ignition switch OFF when the AIR INJ
CHECK operation finishes.
OK:
Air comes out from the air pump
NG
OK
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT NOT RECURS
REPLACE AIR PUMP
ES
ES–418
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2610
ECM / PCM Internal Engine Off Timer Performance
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
Monitoring Item
P2610
Soak timer (built into
ECM)
Malfunction
Detection Condition
ECM internal
malfunction
Trouble Area
ECM
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
Engine running
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
ES
The soak timer is built into the ECM. To ensure that the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) monitor values will
be accurate, the soak timer counts 5 hours (+-15 minutes) from when the ignition switch is turned OFF.
This allows the fuel to cool down, which stabilizes the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5
hours have passed, the ECM turns ON.
Soak Timer Circuit
ECM
Ignition Switch
IGSW
EFI
+B
POWER SOURCE IC
MREL
Main Relay Control IC
Soak Timer IC
Battery
A115729E09
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the soak timer activates the ECM to begin the EVAP
system monitor. While the engine is running, the ECM monitors the synchronization of the soak timer and
the CPU clock. If the soak timer and CPU clock are not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction, illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2610: Soak timer (built into ECM)
Required Sensors/Components
ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
ES–419
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTC not present
None
Ignition switch
ON
Engine
Running
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Soak timer measurement when ECM CPU clock counts 10 minutes
ES
Less than 7 minutes or more than 13 minutes
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• DTC P2610 is set if an internal ECM problem is detected. Diagnostic procedures are not required.
ECM replacement is required.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
1
REPLACE ECM
(a) Replace the ECM (See page ES-510).
NEXT
2
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Clear DTCs (See page ES-35).
(d) Start the engine and wait for 10 minutes or more.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC / INFO / PENDING CODES.
(f) If no pending DTC is displayed, the repair has been
successfully completed.
NEXT
END
ES–420
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2A00
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2A03
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
DESCRIPTION
•
•
•
•
•
ES
DTC P2A00 indicates malfunctions related to the bank 1 A/F sensor.
DTC P2A03 indicates malfunctions related to the bank 2 A/F sensor.
Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes No. 1 cylinder.
Bank 2 refers to the bank that includes No. 2 cylinder.
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted in front of the Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) and is
located near the engine assembly.
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-364).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
P2A00
P2A03
Calculated test value for Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor
response rate deterioration level is less than threshold.
•
•
Open or short in Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (sensor
1) circuit
Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor (sensor 1)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
After engine is warmed up, the ECM performs air fuel ratio feedback control to regulate the air fuel ratio at
stoichiometric ratio. In addition, this vehicle performs Active Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) Control for approximately
10 seconds after preconditions are met in order to measure the A/F sensor response rate. During active
air fuel ratio control, the ECM forcibly increases and decreases the injection volume a certain amount
based on learned stoichiometric air fuel ratio during usual air fuel feedback control, and measures the A/F
sensor response rate. The ECM receives a signal from the A/F sensor while performing active A/F control
and uses it to calculate the A/F sensor response rate deterioration level.
If the test value for A/F sensor response rate deterioration level is less than the threshold, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction, and sets the DTC.
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
10 Seconds
ON
Active A/F Control
OFF
Normal
Malfunction
A/F Sensor Output
Increase
Fuel Injection Volume
Decrease
A115363E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–421
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2A00: Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 1) slow response
P2A03: Air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor (bank 2) slow response
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
A/F sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 to 15 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0308 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0455, P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196, P2198 (A/F sensor - rationality)
P2237, P2240 (A/F sensor - open)
P2440 (AIR control valve stuck open)
P2441 (AIR control valve stuck close)
P2444 (AIP stuck ON)
P2445 (AIP stuck OFF)
Active A/F control
Performing
Active A/F control is performed when the following conditions set
-
Battery Voltage
11 V or more
ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine RPM
Less than 4,000 rpm
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel cut
OFF
Engine load
10 to 70 %
Shift position
2nd or more
Catalyst monitor
Not executing
Intake air amount
2.5 to 12 g/sec.
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Response rate deterioration level
Less than 0.2 V
MONITOR RESULT
Detailed information on CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor response monitor.
ES
ES–422
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed
Between
[H]
25 and 75 mph
(40 and 120 km/h)
Idling
[G]
Ignition Switch OFF
ES
Warming up
3 minutes
Time
A115372E43
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM [A].
Turn the ignition switch ON [B].
Turn the tester ON [C].
Clear DTCs (if set) (See page ES-35) [D].
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR INFO / MONITOR RESULT
[E].
6. Check that RES RATE B1 S1 is INCOMPL [F].
7. Start the engine and warm it up [G].
8. Drive the vehicle at between 25 mph and 75 mph (40 km/h and 120 km/h) for 3 minutes. However, the
vehicle should be driven at a constant speed [H].
9. Check the monitor result values on the intelligent tester by entering the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR INFO / TEST RESULT [I].
10.If the values indicated on the tester do not change, perform READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
for the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor (See page ES-20) [J].
HINT:
Completion of all A/F sensor monitors are required to change the value in TEST RESULT.
11.Note the value of the Monitor Result [K].
12.Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INO / PENDING CODES [L].
13.Check if any pending DTCs are set [M].
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (See page ES-368).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Malfunctioning areas can be identified by performing the A/F CONTROL function provided in the ACTIVE
TEST. The A/F CONTROL function can help to determine whether the Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor, Heated
Oxygen (HO2) sensor and other potential trouble areas are malfunctioning.
The following instructions describe how to conduct the A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
ES–423
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. Start the engine and turn the tester ON.
3. Warm up the engine at an engine speed of 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
4. On the intelligent tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST
/ A/F CONTROL.
5. Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idling condition (press the RIGHT or LEFT
button to change the fuel injection volume).
6. Monitor the output voltages of the A/F and HO2 sensors (AFS B1S1 (AFS B2S1) and O2S B1S2 (O2S
B2S2)) displayed on the tester.
HINT:
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the fuel injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection
volume by 25 %.
• Each sensor reacts in accordance with increases and decreases in the fuel injection volume.
Standard:
Tester Display
(Sensor)
Injection Volume
Status
Voltage
AFS B1S1 (AFS B2S1)
(A/F)
+25 %
Rich
Less than 3.0
AFS B1S1 (AFS B2S1)
(A/F)
-12.5 %
Lean
More than 3.35
O2S B1S2 ( O2S B2S2)
(HO2)
+25 %
Rich
More than 0.55
O2S B1S2 (O2S B2S2)
(HO2)
-12.5 %
Lean
Less than 0.4
NOTICE:
The Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor has an output delay of a few seconds and the Heated Oxygen
(HO2) sensor has a maximum output delay of approximately 20 seconds.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1)
Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2)
Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Injection Volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
2
3
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system
(Air fuel ratio
extremely lean or
rich)
ES
ES–424
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• Following the A/F CONTROL procedure enables technicians to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F and HO2 sensors.
• To display the graph, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
A/F CONTROL / USER DATA / AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2 or AFS B2S1 and O2S B2S2. Then press
the YES button and ENTER button, followed by the F4 button.
HINT:
• DTC P2A00 may be also set when the air fuel ratio is stuck rich or lean.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a rich air fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run rich.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a lean air fuel mixture. Check for conditions that
would cause the engine to run lean.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at
the time of a malfunction.
1
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2A00 AND/OR P2A03)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00 and/or P2A03
A
P2A00 and/or P2A03 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any DTCs other than P2A00 and/or P2A03 are output,
troubleshoot those DTCs first.
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor
A12
A13
HT
+B
AF-
AF+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (1) - +B (2)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
HT (1) - AF- (4)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Front View
A085152E60
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
ES–425
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A12 or A13 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between the +B terminal of the A/F
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A12
A13
+B
HT
AF-
AF+
Front View
ECM Connector
E5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
+B (2) - Body ground
10 V or more
(d) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(f) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (A12-1) - HA1A (E5-2)
HT (A13-1) - HA2A (E5-1)
AF+ (A12-3) - A1A+ (E5-22)
HA1A
A2A+
A2A-
HA2A
AF+ (A13-3) - A2A+ (E5-23)
Below 1 Ω
AF- (A12-4) - A1A- (E5-30)
A1A+
AF- (A13-4) - A2A- (E5-31)
A1AA115727E02
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HT (A12-1) or HA1A (E5-2) - Body
ground
HT (A13-1) or HA2A (E5-1) - Body
ground
AF+ (A12-3) or A1A+ (E5-22) - Body
ground
AF+ (A13-3) or A2A+ (E5-23) - Body
ground
AF- (A12-4) or A1A- (E5-30) - Body
ground
AF- (A13-4) or A2A- (E5-31) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ES
ES–426
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
A/F HEATER
A/F Sensor
ECM
A/F Heater Fuse
Heater
+B
From
Battery
HT
HA1A
AF+
A1A+
Sensor
AF-
Duty
Control
A1A-
ES
From EFI Relay
A118002E16
(g) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
5
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2A00 AND/OR P2A03)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00 and/or P2A03
A
No output
B
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–427
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NEXT
7
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
NEXT
8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2A00 AND/OR P2A03)
(a) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00 and/or P2A03
A
No output
B
A
B
END
CHECK EXTREMELY RICH OR LEAN
ACTUAL AIR FUEL RATIO (REFER TO DTC
P0171 PROCEDURE)
ES
ES–428
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
EVAP System
RELATED DTCS
DTC No.
Monitoring Items
P043E
Reference orifice clogged (built into canister
pump module)
P043F
Reference orifice high-flow (built into canister
pump module)
P0441
•
•
•
P0450
Canister pressure sensor (built into canister
pump module) voltage abnormal fluctuation
•
ES
P0451
•
Purge VSV stuck closed
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge flow
Canister pressure sensor (built into
canister pump module) noising
Canister pressure sensor stuck (built into
canister pump module)
P0452
Canister pressure sensor (built into canister
pump module) voltage low
P0453
Canister pressure sensor (built into canister
pump module) voltage high
P0455
EVAP gross leak
P0456
EVAP small leak
P2401
Leak detection pump stuck OFF (built into
canister pump module)
P2402
Leak detection pump stuck ON (built into
canister pump module)
P2419
Vent valve stuck closed (built into canister
pump module)
P2420
Vent valve stuck open (vent) (built into
canister pump module)
P2610
Soak timer (built into ECM)
See procedure
ES-237
ES-243
ES-251
ES-258
ES-387
ES-393
ES-413
If any EVAP system DTCs are set, the malfunctioning area can be determined using the table below.
ES–429
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTCs
Malfunctioning Areas
P043E
P043F
P0441 P0450 P0451 P0452 P0453 P0455 P0456
P2401
P2419 P2420
P2402
Reference orifice clogged
Reference orifice high-flow
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
Canister pressure sensor stuck
Canister pressure sensor noise
ES
Canister pressure sensor low
output
Canister pressure sensor high
output
Gross leak
Small leak
Leak detection pump stuck OFF
Leak detection pump stuck ON
Vent valve stuck closed
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
A106731E06
NOTICE:
If the 0.02 inch leak criterion difference between the first and second checks is greater than the
specification, the DTCs corresponding to the 0.02 inch leak criterion (P043E, P043F, P0441, P0455,
P0456, P2401 and P2420) will all be stored.
ES–430
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
Location of EVAP (Evaporative Emission) System:
Pump Module
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Pump
Vent Valve
Purge VSV
(Vacuum Switching Valve)
Fuel Tank
EVAP Hose
Air Filter
Canister
(From Canister)
ES
Refueling Valve
Breeding Pipe
Purge Line
EVAP Hose
Fuel Tank Cap
(To Throttle Body)
Air Inlet Port
A130715E01
EVAP System Circuit:
Air Cleaner
Throttle Valve
ECM
Soak Timer
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Pump Module
Canister
Air Filter
Refueling Valve
Restrictor (0.08 inch)
Roll-Over Valve
Cut-Off Valve
Fuel Tank
A130686E01
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–431
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed-loop etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
The following two monitors run to confirm appropriate EVAP system operation.
1. Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours
are required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the
EVAP system monitor more accurate.
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure
is measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the
ignition switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
2. Purge flow monitor
The purge flow monitor consists of the two monitors. The 1st monitor is conducted every time and the
2nd monitor is conducted if necessary.
• The 1st monitor
While the engine is running and the purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV) is ON (open), the ECM
monitors the purge flow by measuring the EVAP pressure change. If negative pressure is not
created, the ECM begins the 2nd monitor.
ES
ES–432
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• The 2nd monitor
The vent valve turned OFF (open) and the EVAP pressure is then measured. If the variation in the
pressure is less than 0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg), the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being stuck
closed, and illuminates the MIL and sets DTC P0441 (2 trip detection logic).
Atmospheric pressure check:
In order to ensure reliable malfunction detection, the variation between the atmospheric
pressures, before and after conduction of the purge flow monitor, is measured by the ECM.
EVAP Purge Flow:
Reference Orifice (0.02 inch)
Refueling Valve
Fuel Cap
Canister Pressure Sensor
To Atmosphere
ES
Purge VSV
(ON)
Fuel Tank
Canister
To Intake Manifold
Canister Filter
Vent Valve (OFF)
ECM
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Canister Pump Module
Soak Timer
A122571E01
Components
Operations
Canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON, closed: OFF).
Refueling valve
Controls EVAP pressure from fuel tank to canister. Valve consists of
diaphragm, spring and restrictor (diameter: 0.08 inch). When fuel
vapor and pressure inside fuel tank increase, valve opens. While
EVAP purged, valve closes and restrictor prevents large amount of
vacuum from affecting pressure in fuel tank. Valve opens while
refueling.
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours*
(+-15 min) after ignition switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours*
elapsed, ECM activates.
Canister pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. canister pump module cannot be
disassembled.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
ES–433
Operations
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When, ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump (refer to fig. 1).
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure (refer to fig. 2).
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
(d) Reference orifice
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump, to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C after 5 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C 7 hours after the
ignition switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Canister Pump Module (fig. 1):
Condition: Purge Flow
Vent Valve: OFF
(vent)
: Airflow
Condition: Leak Check
To Canister
Filter
(Atmosphere):
Canister
Vent Valve: ON
(closed)
Reference Orifice
Canister Pressure Sensor
From Refueling Valve
Leak Detection Pump: ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
A097611E07
ES
ES–434
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification (fig. 2):
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (759.8mmHg)
A115543E02
Soak Timer Circuit (fig.3)
ECM
Ignition Switch
IGSW
EFI
+B
POWER SOURCE IC
MREL
Main Relay Control IC
Soak Timer IC
Battery
A115729E10
ES–435
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
35
IC4
W-G
J4
J/C
L-W
A
A
L-W
W-G
17
L-W
IC3
12
L-W
IM1
2
2
1 IB2
BR
22
IM2
BR
28
E4 E2
L-R
42
IE1
L-R
7
IM2
L-R
23
E4 VC
R
17
IE1
R
22
E8 PPMP
R-G
11
IE1
R-G
5
E8 VPMP
O
28
IE1
O
6
E8 MPMP
L-W
3
EFI
Relay
9
Engine
Room R/B
3
8
5
1
2
W-B
Engine Room R/B
B J2
J/C
Battery
L
B J3
ES
43
IE1
4
2
2
1
34
E4 PRG
BR
2
B
2
Y-R
Engine
Room
R/B
L-W L4
EFI
Canister Pump Module
No. 2
1
1
C
L-W
C
2
A
2
2
V2 VSV (EVAP)
J28
J/C
8
E8 MREL
EFI
2
2
1
2
B
W-B
EB
A133741E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
HINT:
• Using the intelligent tester monitor results enables the EVAP system to be confirmed.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame
data can be helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, whether the engine
was warmed up or not, whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as other data recorded at the
time of a malfunction.
ES–436
1
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II/ DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Confirm DTCs and freeze frame data.
If any EVAP system DTCs are set, the malfunctioning
area can be determined using the table below.
NOTICE:
If the 0.02 inch leak criterion difference between the
first and second checks is greater than the
specification, the DTCs corresponding to the 0.02
inch leak criterion (P043E, P043F, P0441, P0455,
P0456, P2401 and P2420) will all be stored.
ES
DTCs
Malfunctioning Areas
P043E
P043F
P0441 P0450 P0451 P0452 P0453 P0455 P0456
P2401
P2419 P2420
P2402
Reference orifice clogged
Reference orifice high-flow
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
Canister pressure sensor stuck
Canister pressure sensor noise
Canister pressure sensor low
output
Canister pressure sensor high
output
Gross leak
Small leak
Leak detection pump stuck OFF
Leak detection pump stuck ON
Vent valve stuck closed
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
A106731E06
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–437
NEXT
2
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION)
NOTICE:
• The EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION)
consists of five steps performed automatically by the
intelligent tester. It takes a maximum of approximately
18 minutes.
• Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the
fuel tank is more than 90 % full because the cut-off
valve may be closed, making the leak check of the fuel
tank not possible.
• Do not run the engine in this step.
• When the temperature of the fuel is 35°C (95°F) or
more, a large amount of vapor forms and any check
results become inaccurate. When performing the
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below
35°C (95°F).
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK is completed, check
for pending DTCs by entering the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed, perform the Monitor
Confirmation (see "Diagnostic Help" menu). After this
confirmation, check for pending DTCs. If no DTC is
displayed, the EVAP system is normal.
NEXT
ES
ES–438
3
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (MANUAL OPERATION)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ES
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Gross Leak
Negative
0.02 Inch Leak
Criterion
[Second 0.02
Inch Leak
Criterion] x 0.2
Small Leak
No Leak
Normal Pressure
Steps
1/5
2/5
3/5
4/5
5/5
Time (Second)
10
60
Within 15 minutes
10
60
(Reference)
A106735E06
NOTICE:
• In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (MANUAL OPERATION),
the series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK steps are
performed manually by the intelligent tester.
• Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the
fuel tank is more than 90 % full because the cut-off
valve may be closed, making the leak check of the fuel
tank not possible.
• Do not run the engine in this step.
• When the temperature of the fuel is 35°C (95°F) or
more, a large amount of vapor forms and any check
results become inaccurate. When performing the
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below
35°C (95°F).
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK /
MANUAL OPERATION.
NEXT
ES–439
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 1/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
ES
Canister Pressure Sensor Noise
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
First Reference
Pressure
Steps
OK
1/5
Time (Second)
10
(Reference)
A106736E04
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 1/5.
Result
DTC No. *
P0451
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Virtually no variation in EVAP
pressure
Not yet determined
A
EVAP pressure fluctuates by +0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
Canister pressure sensor noise
B
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
B
A
Go to step 30
ES–440
5
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 1/5 TO 2/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ES
Vent Valve
ON
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Leak Detection Pump Stuck ON
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Steps
Time (Second)
1/5
2/5
10
60
(Reference)
A106737E04
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 1/5 and 2/5.
Result
DTC No. *
Test Results
-
Virtually no variation in EVAP
pressure during step 1/5. Then
decreases to 0.02 inch leak
criterion
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Not yet determined
A
P2402
Small difference between EVAP
pressures during steps 1/5 and
2/5
Leak detection pump stuck ON
B
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
HINT:
The first 0.02 inch leak criterion is the value determined
in step 2/5.
B
A
Go to step 23
ES–441
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 2/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
EVAP Pressure
ON
ES
Leak Detection Pump Stuck OFF
Reference Orifice High-flow
4 seconds
Positive
Negative
Vent Valve Stuck Closed
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Steps
Time (Second)
OK
1/5
2/5
10
60
3/5
Within 15 minutes
(Reference)
A106738E04
HINT:
Make a note of the pressures checked in the steps below.
(a) Check the EVAP pressure 4 seconds after the leak
detection pump is activated* [A}.
(b) Check the EVAP pressure again when it has stabilized.
This pressure is the 0.02 inch leak criterion [B}.
*: The leak detection pump begins to operate as step 1/5
proceeds to step 2/5.
Result
DTC No. *
-
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
EVAP pressure in step [B]
between -4.85 kPa and -1.06
kPa (-36.38 mmHg and -7.95
mmHg)
Proceed to
Not yet determined
A
•
•
B
Reference orifice high-flow
Leak detection pump stuck
OFF
P043F and P2401
EVAP pressure in step [B] -1.06
kPa (-7.95 mmHg) or more
P043E
EVAP pressure in step [B]
below -4.85 kPa (-36.38 mmHg)
Reference orifice clogged
C
P2419
EVAP pressure in step [A] more
than -1.06 kPa (-7.95 mmHg)
Vent valve stuck closed
D
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
ES–442
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
Go to step 11
C
Go to step 30
D
Go to step 19
A
7
ES
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 2/5 TO 3/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Vent Valve Stuck
Open (vent)
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Steps
3/5
2/5
Time
Within 15 minutes
(Reference)
A106739E04
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 3/5.
Result
DTC No. *
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
EVAP pressure increases by
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
within 10 seconds of
proceeding from step 2/5 to
step 3/5
Not yet determined
A
P2420
No variation in EVAP pressure
despite proceeding from step
2/5 to step 3/5
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
B
P0451
No variation in EVAP pressure
during steps 1/5 through 3/5
Canister pressure sensor
malfunction (stuck)
C
-
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
ES–443
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
Go to step 20
C
Go to step 30
A
8
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 3/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Steps
Time
3/5
Within 15 minutes
(Reference)
A106740E04
(a) Wait until the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa
(0.75 mmHg) for 30 seconds.
(b) Measure the EVAP pressure and record it.
HINT:
A few minutes are required for the EVAP pressure to
become saturated. When there is little fuel in the fuel
tank, it takes up to 15 minutes (900 seconds).
NEXT
ES
ES–444
9
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 4/5)
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ES
ON: Open
ON
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
Purge VSV Stuck Closed
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
4/5
Steps
Time (Second)
10
(Reference)
A106741E04
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 4/5.
Result
DTC No. *
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
-
EVAP pressure increases by
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
within 10 seconds of
proceeding from step 3/5 to
step 4/5
Not yet determined
A
P0441
EVAP pressure increases by
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
within 10 seconds of
proceeding from step 3/5 to
step 4/5
Problems in EVAP hose
between purge VSV and intake
manifold
B
P0441
Variation in EVAP pressure less
than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) for
10 seconds, after proceeding
from step 3/5 to step 4/5
Purge VSV stuck closed
C
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
B
Go to step 15
C
Go to step 12
ES–445
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
10
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 5/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ES
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Gross Leak
Negative
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
[Second 0.02
Inch Leak
Criterion] x 0.2
Small Leak
Second 0.02
Inch Leak
Criterion
No Leak
5/5
Steps
60
Time (Second)
(Reference)
A106735E07
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 5/5.
(b) Compare the EVAP pressure in step 3/5 and the second
0.02 inch leak criterion (step 5/5).
Result
DTC No. *
Test Results
-
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) lower
than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion (step 5/5)
Suspected Trouble Areas
Not yet determined
A
P0441 and P0455
EVAP pressure (step 3/5)
higher than [second 0.02 inch
leak criterion (step 5/5) x 0.2]
•
•
B
P0456
EVAP pressure (step 3/5)
higher than second 0.02 inch
leak criterion (step 5/5)
EVAP small leak
Purge VSV stuck open
EVAP gross leak
Proceed to
B
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
A
Go to step 36
B
Go to step 12
ES–446
11
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (STEP 3/5)
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ES
ON: Closed
ON
ON
Leak Detection Pump
Stuck OFF
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Reference Orifice
High-flow
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Steps
2/5
3/5
Time
Within 15 minutes
(Reference)
A106742E03
(a) Check the EVAP pressure in step 3/5.
Result
DTC No. *
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
P043F
EVAP pressure less than [0.02
inch leak criterion] measured
at 2/5
Reference orifice high-flow
A
P2401
EVAP pressure almost same as
[0.02 inch leak criterion]
measured at 2/5
Leak detection pump stuck
OFF
B
*: These DTCs are already present in the ECM when the
vehicle arrives and are confirmed in step 1.
HINT:
The first 0.02 inch leak criterion is the value determined
in step 2/5.
A
Go to step 30
B
Go to step 23
ES–447
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
12
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (PURGE VSV)
Purge VSV
Hose
A115730E01
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(b) Disconnect the hose (connected to the canister) from the
purge VSV.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Using the tester, turn the purge VSV OFF (EVAP VSV:
OFF).
(e) Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has no
suction.
(f) Using the tester, turn the purge VSV ON (EVAP VSV:
ON).
(g) Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has
suction.
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
No suction when purge VSV turned OFF,
and suction applied when turned ON
Purge VSV normal
A
Suction applied when purge VSV turned
OFF
Purge VSV stuck open
B
•
•
C
No suction when purge VSV turned ON
Purge VSV stuck closed
Problems with EVAP hose between
purge VSV and intake manifold
B
Go to step 14
C
Go to step 15
A
13
CHECK FUEL CAP
(a) Check that the fuel cap is correctly installed.
(1) Tighten the fuel cap until a few click sounds are
heard.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, use the tester to
check the fuel cap.
(b) Remove the fuel cap and install it onto the fuel cap
adaptor.
(c) Connect an EVAP tester pump hose to the adaptor, and
pressurize the cap to 3.2 to 3.7 kPa (24 to 28 mmHg)
using an EVAP tester pump.
(d) Seal the adaptor and wait for 2 minutes.
(e) Check the pressure. If the pressure is 2 kPa (15 mmHg)
or more, the fuel cap is normal.
(f) Reinstall the fuel cap.
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Fuel cap correctly installed
-
A
ES
ES–448
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Fuel cap loose
No fuel cap
ES
14
Proceed to
Fuel cap improperly installed
Defective fuel cap
Fuel cap does not meet OEM
specifications
B
-
C
A
Go to step 29
B
Go to step 27
C
Go to step 28
INSPECT PURGE VSV
Hose
Purge VSV
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the V2 purge VSV connector.
(c) Disconnect the hose (connected to the canister) from the
purge VSV.
(d) Start the engine.
(e) Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has no
suction.
A115731E01
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
No suction
ECM
A
Suction applied
Purge VSV
B
(f)
15
Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
A
Go to step 35
B
Go to step 31
CHECK EVAP HOSE (PURGE VSV - INTAKE MANIFOLD)
Purge VSV
Hose
(a) Disconnect the hose (connected to the intake manifold)
from the purge VSV.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Use your finger to confirm that the hose has suction.
A115730E01
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Suction applied
EVAP hose between purge VSV and intake
manifold normal
A
ES–449
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Test Results
•
•
No suction
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Intake manifold port
EVAP hose between purge VSV and
intake manifold
B
B
Go to step 26
A
16
INSPECT DUTY PURGE VSV
(a) Remove the purge VSV connector.
(b) Apply battery voltage to the terminals of the purge VSV.
(c) Using an air gun, confirm that air flows from port A to port
B.
Battery
B
A
Air
A133742E01
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Air flows
Purge VSV normal
A
No air flows
Purge VSV
B
B
Go to step 31
A
17
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE OF PURGE VSV)
(a) Disconnect the V2 purge VSV connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal 2 of the purge
VSV connector and the body ground.
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV
Connector
V2
Front View
A052933E30
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 11 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Other than result above
Wire harness or connectors between
purge VSV and ECM
B
(d) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
B
Go to step 32
ES
ES–450
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
18
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V2 purge VSV connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV Connector
V2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V2-1 - PRG (E4-34)
Below 1 Ω
V2-1 or PRG (E4-34) - Body ground
V2-1 - Body ground
Front View
ES
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
ECM Connector
E4
OK
Go to step 35
NG
Go to step 32
PRG
A115732E02
19
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FOR VENT VALVE)
ECM Connector
E8
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE (ALONE).
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal VPMP of the
ECM connector and the body ground when the vent
valve is turned ON (close) and OFF (vent) using the
tester.
VPMP
E118245E26
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF
Below 3 V when ON
Vent valve
A
Below 3 V when OFF and ON
ECM
B
A
Go to step 22
B
Go to step 35
ES–451
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
20
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FOR VENT VALVE)
ECM Connector
E8
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE (ALONE).
(c) Measure the voltage between terminal VPMP of the
ECM connector and the body ground when the vent
valve is turned ON (close) and OFF (vent) using the
tester.
VPMP
E118245E26
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Below 3 V when OFF and ON
Power source of vent valve
A
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF
Below 3 V when ON
Vent valve
B
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF and ON
ECM
C
B
Go to step 22
C
Go to step 35
A
21
INSPECT CANISTER PUMP MODULE (POWER SOURCE FOR VENT VALVE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
L4
Wire Harness Side
Canister Connector
L4
Front View
A115733E02
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between terminal 9 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
ES
ES–452
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 9 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Between 0 V and 3 V
Power source wire harness of vent valve
B
B
Go to step 32
A
22
INSPECT CANISTER PUMP MODULE (VENT VALVE OPERATION)
Charcoal Canister Assembly
9(+)
8(-)
ES
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(c) Apply the battery voltage to terminals 9 and 8 of the
canister pump module.
(d) Touch the canister pump module to confirm the vent
valve operation.
A115734E01
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Operating
Wire harness between vent valve and ECM
A
Not operating
Vent valve
B
(e) Reconnect the canister connector.
23
A
Go to step 32
B
Go to step 30
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (FOR CANISTER PUMP MODULE
[LEAK DETECTION PUMP])
ECM Connector
E8
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP (ALONE).
(b) Measure the voltage between MPMP terminal of the
ECM connector and the body ground when the leak
detection pump is turned ON and OFF using the tester.
MPMP
E118245E27
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 0 V and 3 V when OFF
Between 9 V and 14 V when ON
ECM normal
A
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF
Between 0 V and 3 V when ON
ECM
B
ES–453
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
Go to step 35
A
24
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP (ALONE).
(e) Turn the leak detection pump ON.
(f) Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
L4
Wire Harness Side
Canister Connector
L4
Front View
A115733E02
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Between 9 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Between 0 V and 3 V
Wire harness between ECM and leak
detection pump
B
(g) Reconnect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 32
A
25
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the L4 canister connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors between terminal 6 of the canister connector
and the body ground.
Wire Harness Side
L4
Canister
Connector
Front View
A085258E53
ES
ES–454
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Below 1 Ω
Leak detection pump
A
10 kΩ or higher
Wire harness between leak detection
pump and body ground
B
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
26
A
Go to step 30
B
Go to step 32
INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD (EVAP PURGE PORT)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ES
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the EVAP hose from the throttle body.
Start the engine.
Use your finger to confirm that the port of the throttle
body has suction.
Result
27
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Suction applied
EVAP hose between intake manifold and
purge VSV
A
No suction
Intake manifold
B
A
Go to step 33
B
Go to step 34
CORRECTLY REINSTALL OR REPLACE FUEL CAP
HINT:
• When reinstalling the fuel cap, tighten it until a few click
sounds are heard.
• When replacing the fuel cap, use a fuel cap that meets
OEM specifications, and tighten it until a few click sounds
are heard.
NEXT
28
Go to step 37
REPLACE FUEL CAP
HINT:
When installing the fuel cap, tighten it until a few click sounds
are heard.
NEXT
29
Go to step 37
LOCATE EVAP LEAK
(a) Reinstall the fuel cap.
(b) Disconnect the vent hose.
ES–455
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister
ES
Disconnect the Vent Hose here.
Fuel Cap
A130688E01
(c) Connect the EVAP pressure tester tool to the canister
with the adapter.
Canister
Pressure Gauge
Air Filter
Adapter
A130689E01
(d) Pressurize the EVAP system to 3.2 to 3.7 kPa (24 to 28
mmHg).
(e) Apply soapy water to the piping and connecting parts of
the EVAP system.
(f) Look for areas where bubbles appear. This indicates
leak point.
(g) Repair or replace the leak point.
ES–456
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
Disconnect the hose between the canister and the fuel tank
from the canister. Block the canister side and conduct an
inspection. In this way, the fuel tank can be excluded as an
area suspected of causing fuel leaks.
NEXT
30
Go to step 37
REPLACE CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the canister assembly.
NOTICE:
When replacing the canister, check the canister
pump module interior and related pipes for water,
fuel or other liquids. If liquids are present, check for
disconnections and/or cracks in the following: 1) the
pipe from the air inlet port to the canister pump
module; 2) the canister filter; and 3) the fuel tank
vent hose.
ES
NEXT
31
Go to step 37
REPLACE DUTY PURGE VSV
(a) Disconnect the connector and hoses from the purge
VSV.
(b) Remove the purge VSV.
(c) Install a new purge VSV.
(d) Reconnect the connector and hose.
NEXT
32
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
NEXT
33
Go to step 37
REPLACE EVAP HOSE (INTAKE MANIFOLD - PURGE VSV)
NEXT
34
Go to step 37
Go to step 37
INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD (EVAP PURGE PORT)
(a) Remove the throttle body (See page ES-495).
(b) Check that the EVAP purge port of the intake manifold is
not clogged. If necessary, replace the intake manifold.
NEXT
Go to step 37
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
35
ES–457
REPLACE ECM
(a) Replace the ECM (See page ES-510).
NEXT
36
Go to step 37
REPAIR OR REPLACE PARTS AND COMPONENTS INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTCS
(a) Repair the malfunctioning areas indicated by the DTCs
that had been confirmed when the vehicle was brought
in.
NEXT
37
Go to step 37
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION)
NOTICE:
• The EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION)
consists of five steps performed automatically by the
intelligent tester. It takes a maximum of approximately
18 minutes.
• Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the
fuel tank is more than 90 % full because the cut-off
valve may be closed, making the leak check of the fuel
tank not possible.
• Do not run the engine in this step.
• When the temperature of the fuel is 35°C (95°F) or
more, a large amount of vapor forms and any check
results become inaccurate. When performing an EVAP
SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below 35°C
(95°F).
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page ES-35).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the SYSTEM CHECK is completed, check for
pending DTCs by entering the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO /
PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is found, the repair has been
successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
After a repair, check Monitor Status by performing the key-off monitor confirmation and purge flow monitor
confirmation described below.
ES
ES–458
1.
ES
2.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Key-off monitor confirmation
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• The vehicle has been driven for 10 minutes or more (in a city area or on a freeway)
• The fuel tank is less than 90 % full
• The altitude is less than 8,000 ft (2,400 m)
• The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is between 4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
• The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is between 4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
• The vehicle remains stationary (the vehicle speed is 0 km/h (0 mph))
(b) Monitor Conditions
1. Allow the engine to idle for at least 5 minutes.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 6 hours (8 or 10.5 hours).
HINT:
Do not Start the engine until checking MONITOR STATUS. If the engine is started, the steps
described above must be repeated.
(c) Monitor Status
1. Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
2. Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
3. Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR STATUS.
4. Check the Monitor Status displayed on the tester.
HINT:
If INCMP is displayed, the monitor is not completed. Make sure that the preconditions have
been met, and perform the Monitor Conditions again.
Purge flow monitor confirmation (P0441)
HINT:
Perform this monitor confirmation after the key-off monitor confirmation shows COMPL (complete).
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• The vehicle has been driven for 10 minutes or more (in a city area or on a freeway)
• The ECT is between 4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
• The IAT is between 4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
(b) Monitor Conditions
1. Release the pressure from the fuel tank by removing and reinstalling the fuel cap.
2. Warm the engine up until the ECT reaches more than 75°C (167°F).
3. Increase the engine speed to 3,000 rpm once.
4. Allow the engine to idle and turn the A/C ON for 1 minute.
(c) Monitor Status
1. Turn the ignition switch OFF (where ON or the engine is running).
2. Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
3. Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
4. Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR STATUS.
5. Check the Monitor Status displayed on the tester.
HINT:
If INCMP is displayed, the monitor is not completed. Make sure that the preconditions have
been met, and perform the "Monitor Conditions" procedures again.
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (See page ES-17).
ES–36
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
ES
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting On-Board Diagnostics (OBD II)
vehicles, the intelligent tester (complying with SAE
J1987) must be connected to the Data Link Connector 3
(DLC3) of the vehicle. Various data in the vehicle's
Engine Control Module (ECM) can then be read.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle's on-board
computer illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer
detects a malfunction in:
(a)The emission control systems components
(b)The powertrain control components (which affect
vehicle emissions)
(c) The computer itself
In addition, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes
(DTCs) prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory. If the malfunction does not recur in 3
consecutive trips, the MIL turns off automatically but the
DTCs remain recorded in the ECM memory.
FI00534E01
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A072434E01
2.
To check the DTCs, connect the intelligent tester to the
DLC3. The tester displays DTCs, freeze frame data, and
a variety of engine data. The DTCs and freeze frame
data can be erased with the tester (See page ES-48). In
order to enhance OBD function on vehicles and develop
the Off-Board diagnosis system, the Control Area
Network (CAN) communication is used in this system. It
minimizes the gap between technician skills and vehicle
technology. CAN is a network which uses a pair of data
transmission lines that span multiple ECUs and sensors.
It allows high speed communication between the
systems and simplifies the wire harness connections.
The CAN Vehicle Interface Module (CAN VIM) must be
connected with the intelligent tester to display any
information from the ECM. The intelligent tester and
ECM uses CAN communication signals to communicate.
Connect the CAN VIM between the intelligent tester and
DLC3.
NORMAL MODE AND CHECK MODE
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode during
normal vehicle use. In normal mode, 2 trip detection
logic is used to ensure accurate detection of
malfunctions. Check mode is also available as an option
for technicians. In check mode, 1 trip detection logic is
used for simulating malfunction symptoms and
increasing the system's ability to detect malfunctions,
including intermittent problems (intelligent tester only)
(See page ES-36).
ES–37
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3.
4.
5.
DLC3
2 TRIP DETECTION LOGIC
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is
temporarily stored in the ECM memory (1st trip). If the
same malfunction is detected during the next
subsequent drive cycle, the MIL is illuminated (2nd trip).
FREEZE FRAME DATA
The ECM records vehicle and driving condition
information as freeze frame data the moment a DTC is
stored. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can be
helpful in determining whether the vehicle was running or
stopped, whether the engine was warmed up or not,
whether the air/fuel ratio was lean or rich, as well as
other data recorded at the time of a malfunction.
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 3 (DLC3)
The vehicle's ECM uses the ISO 15765-4 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of
the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the
ISO 15765-4 format.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 1112131415 16
A082779E98
Symbol (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
9 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
6 kΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
200 Ω or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
6 kΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
200 Ω or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester to the DLC3,
turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to use the tester.
If the display indicates that a communication error has
occurred, there is a problem either with the vehicle or
with the tester.
If communication is normal when the tester is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the original
vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem may be in the
tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed in the
tester's instruction manual.
ES
ES–38
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6.
ES
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the
battery before proceeding.
7. MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
(a) The MIL is illuminated when the ignition switch is
first turned ON (the engine is not running).
(b) The MIL should turn OFF when the engine is
started. If the MIL remains illuminated, the diagnosis
system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in
the system.
HINT:
If the MIL is not illuminated when the ignition switch is first
turned ON, check the MIL circuit (See page ES-479 ).
8. ALL READINESS
For the vehicle, using the intelligent tester allows
readiness codes corresponding to all DTCs to be read.
When diagnosis (normal or malfunctioning) has been
complete, readiness codes are set. Enter the following
menus: ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR STATUS on the
intelligent tester.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–459
ECM Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, the positive battery voltage is applied to terminal IGSW of the ECM
and the EFI relay control circuit in the ECM sends a signal to terminal MREL of the ECM switching on the
EFI relay.
This signal causes current to flow to the coil, closing the contacts of the EFI relay and supplying power to
terminal +B of the ECM.
If the ignition switch is turned OFF, the ECM holds the EFI relay for a maximum of 2 seconds to allow for
the initial setting of the throttle valve.
ES
ES–460
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
I18
Ignition Switch
Driver Side J/B
B-R
7 AM2
ES
IG2 6
R
B
B-O
2
2
B
B
J31
B-O
J/C
35
IC4
W-G
B
J32
B-O
5
AM2
EFI
2
1
EFI
Relay
3
2
2
2
2
A J32
Engine Room R/B
W-B
J/C
C J31
B J2
B
1
E8 +B
1
E6 E1
B
1
9
E8 IGSW
8
E8 MREL
W-G
B
2
1
11
1J
L
2
2
IGN
6
1D
ECM
J8
J/C
W-B
J/C
B
B
B J3
W-B
Battery
EB
11
IC4
EE
A130724E01
ES–461
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ECM (+B VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM Connector
E6
E8
OK
E1 (-)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
+B (E8-1) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
+B (+)
E118245E28
ES
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
ECM Connector
E6
NG
E1
G035617E07
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E1 (E6-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK ECM (IGSW VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM Connector
E6
E8
OK
E1 (-)
IGSW (+)
E118245E29
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGSW (E8-9) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
Go to step 6
ES–462
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT FUSE (IGN)
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel junction
block RH.
(b) Measure the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Driver Side
J/B:
NG
IGN Fuse
REPLACE FUSE
A072891E01
ES
OK
5
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Component Side: Ignition Switch
ACC
I18
IG1
4
8
ST2
AM1
3
7
2
6
AM2
ST1
1
5
(a) Remove the lower finish panel.
(b) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the ignition switch.
Standard resistance
Switch position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
All Terminals
10 kΩ or higher
IG2
Front View
ACC
2-3
ON
2-3, 2-4
6-7
START
1-2, 2-4
6-7, 6-8
A087913E10
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reconnect the ignition switch connector.
NG
REPLACE IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (BATTERY - IGNITION SWITCH, IGNITION
SWITCH - ECM)
6
CHECK ECM (MREL VOLTAGE)
ECM Connector
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E1 (-)
E6
E8
NG
STSW (+)
MREL (+)
E118245E30
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MREL (E8-8) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM
ES–463
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
7
INSPECT FUSE (EFI)
Engine
Room R/B:
EFI Fuse
(a) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EFI fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
ES
A072881E03
OK
8
INSPECT EFI RELAY (Marking: EFI)
(a) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E03
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall EFI relay.
NG
REPLACE EFI RELAY
OK
9
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
E8
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MREL (E8-8) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reconnect the ECM connector.
MREL
A115739E02
NG
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–464
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
VC Output Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The ECM constantly generates 5 V power from the battery voltage supplied to the +B (BATT) terminal to
operate the microprocessor. The ECM also provides this power to the sensors through the VC output
circuit.
ECM
From MAIN Fuse
ES
From EFI Fuse
Throttle Position Sensor, Camshaft
Position Sensor, etc. (Sensors which
have IC)
BATT
5 V Constant Voltage Circuit
+B
Microprocessor
VC
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor,
Intake Air Temperature, etc.
R
A116143E03
When the VC circuit is short-circuited, the microprocessor in the ECM and sensors that are supplied
power through the VC circuit are deactivated because the power is not supplied from the VC circuit. Under
this condition, the system does not start up and the MIL does not illuminate even if the system
malfunctions.
HINT:
Under normal conditions, the MIL is illuminated for several seconds when the ignition switch is first turned
ON. The MIL goes off when the engine is started.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to the following pages.
• Throttle position sensor circuit (See page ES-122).
• Canister pump module circuit (See page ES-430).
• Secondary air injection pressure sensor circuit (See page ES-217).
• Camshaft position sensor circuit (See page ES-195).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MIL
(a) Check that the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) lights
up when turning the ignition switch ON.
OK:
MIL lights up
OK
SYSTEM OK
ES–465
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION BETWEEN INTELLIGENT TESTER AND ECM
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and intelligent tester ON.
(c) Check the communication between the intelligent tester
and ECM.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Communication is possible
A
Communication is impossible
B
A
GO TO MIL CIRCUIT
B
3
INSPECT ECM
E4
VC(+)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage between E4-23 (VC) and E6-1 (E1)
of the ECM connectors.
Standard voltage:
Voltage is not 5 V
E6
E1(-) ECM Connector
E118211E02
NEXT
4
CHECK MIL (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the T2 throttle body connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
B
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
ES
ES–466
5
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK MIL (CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the C1 camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
ES
REPLACE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
B
6
CHECK MIL (CANISTER PUMP MODULE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the spare tire.
Disconnect the L4 canister pump module connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the MIL.
L4
A121725E02
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
REPLACE CANISTER
B
7
CHECK MIL (PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the intake manifold (see page EM-84).
Disconnect the A45 pressure sensor.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the MIL.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
REPLACE AIR SWITCHING VALVE
ES–467
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
E4
VC
NG
ECM Connector
G035615E10
OK
REPLACE ECM
Disconnect the T2 throttle body connector.
Disconnect the C1 camshaft position sensor connector.
Disconnect the L4 canister pump module connector.
Disconnect the A45 pressure sensor.
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance (check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VC (E4-23) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES–493
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSPECTION
1.
Acceptable
RESISTANCE
kΩ
TEMPERATURE °C (°F)
Z017274E14
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance:
20°C (68°F):
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
80°C (176°F):
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
NOTICE:
If inspecting the water temperature sensor
in water, prevent water from flowing into the
terminals. After inspection, wipe the water
off the sensor.
ES
ES–468
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fuel Pump Control Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0230 (See page ES-168).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0230 (See page ES-170).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION
(a) Check if there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose.
HINT:
If there is fuel pressure, you will hear the sound of fuel
flowing.
ES
OK
Go to step 10
NG
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP / SPD.
(d) Check the relay operation when it is operated by the
intelligent tester.
Standard:
Operating sound can be heard from the relay.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
3
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY (Marking: C/OPN)
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the circuit opening relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
NG
REPLACE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
ES–469
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
4
INSPECT ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the E8 and E6 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
ECM Connector
E6
E8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
FC (E8-10) - E1 (E6-1)
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE ECM
E1 (-)
FC (+)
ES
E118245E31
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (ECM - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY, CIRCUIT
OPENING RELAY - IGNITION SWITCH)
5
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Check the ECM Power Source Circuit (See page ES454).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
6
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuel pump relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
A030519E02
(c) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RELAY
ES–470
7
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT FUEL PUMP
(a) Check the fuel pump operation (See page FU-17).
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL PUMP - FUEL PUMP RELAY, FUEL PUMP BODY GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump and fuel pump relay.
(1) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(2) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room
R/B.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
ES
Fuel Pump Connector
F14
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Fuel pump (F14-4) - Engine room R/B (Fuel pump
relay terminal 4)
Below 1 Ω
Front View
Engine Room R/B:
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Fuel Pump Relay
A138159E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Fuel pump (F14-4) or Engine room R/B (Fuel
pump relay terminal 4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(b) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump and body ground.
(1) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector and body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine room R/B (Fuel pump relay terminal 5) Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ES–471
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
9
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY - FUEL PUMP RELAY)
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the engine room
R/B.
(b) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room R/B.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room R/B:
Circuit
Opening
Relay
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Circuit opening relay (3) - Engine room R/B (Fuel
pump relay terminal 3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Circuit opening relay (3) or Engine room R/B (Fuel
pump relay terminal 3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
(e) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Fuel Pump Relay
A138160E01
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EFI RELAY - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY)
10
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY
(a) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuel pump relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
A030519E02
(c) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RELAY
ES
ES–472
11
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RESISTOR (RESISTANCE)
Ohmmeter
(a) Inspect the fuel pump resistor resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance of the terminals.
Resistance:
0.70 to 0.76 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP RESISTOR
A072544E05
ES
OK
12
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL PUMP RELAY - FUEL PUMP RESISTOR,
FUEL PUMP RESISTOR - FUEL PUMP)
(a) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump relay and fuel pump resistor.
(1) Remove the fuel pump relay from the engine room
R/B.
(2) Disconnect the F8 fuel pump resistor connector.
(3) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room R/B:
Fuel Pump Relay
Wire Harness Side:
Fuel Pump Resistor Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine room R/B (Fuel pump relay terminal 5) Fuel pump resistor (F8-1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
F8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine room R/B (Fuel pump relay terminal 5) or
Fuel pump resistor (F8-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the fuel pump relay.
(5) Reconnect the fuel pump resistor connector.
(b) Check the harness and connector between the fuel
pump resistor and fuel pump.
(1) Disconnect the F8 fuel pump resistor connector.
(2) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(3) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Front View
Wire Harness Side:
Fuel Pump Connector
F14
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Fuel pump resistor (F8-2) - Fuel pump (F14-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Front View
A138161E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Fuel pump resistor (F8-2) or Fuel pump (F14-4) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the fuel pump resistor connector.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–473
(d) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ES
ES–474
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Cranking Holding Function Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The starter is controlled by the ECM. When the ECM detects a start signal (STSW) from the ignition
switch, this system monitors the engine speed (NE) and continues to operate the starter until it has
determined that the engine has started (engine speed reaches approximately 500 rpm). If the engine is
already running and the ignition switch is turned to START, the ECM will not operate the starter.
ACC CUT Relay
STA Relay
EFI
Ignition SW
ES
STSW
AM2
ACC
ST2
ACCR
P
STAR
N
ACCR
ST2
Park/Neutral
Starter Position SW
ENG rpm
STAR
Battery
ECM
STSW
STA
A074731E04
ES–475
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
7
8
AM2
ECM
Driver Side J/B
I18
Ignition SW
G-B
ST2
3
1D
STA No. 2
2
1K
6
IM2
L-Y
L-Y
12
E6 STSW
R
B-Y
R
2
2
5
2
AM2
2
P
1
P1
Park / Neutral
Position
Switch
4
STA
Relay
1
N
P
3
B-Y
2
2
2
Engine Room R/B
5
B-Y
A
2
Y-G
ES
8
E5 STAR /
NSW
R
B-Y
J28
J/C
W-B
A
11
E6 STA
A
B-Y
6 EA1
B
B
J3
J/C
Y-G
11 IM1
2 IC4
B
1
S2
1
S3
B-Y
W-B
Starter
Battery
EB
B-Y
G
G
J35
J/C
A130725E01
ES–476
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF ENGINE CRANKING
(a) When turning the ignition switch to the START position
check if the starter motor starts.
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Enter the following menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBDII / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / STARTER SIG.
(c) Confirm the starter signal status when the ignition switch
is operated.
ES
OK
Ignition Switch Position
STARTER SIG
ON
OFF
Start
ON
OK
Go to step 5
NG
3
INSPECT ECM (STA AND STSW VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the E6 ECM connector while
cranking the engine (ignition switch is in the START
position).
Standard voltage
ECM Connector
E6
E1 (-)
Tester Connection
STA (E6-11) - E1 (E6-1)
STSW (E6-12) - E1 (E6-1)
Specified Condition
9 to 14 V
STSW (+)
STA (+)
E118245E13
Result
Terminal STSW
Terminal STA
9 to 14 V
9 to 14 V
A
B
0V
0V
B
C
A
Proceed to
C
REPLACE ECM
Go to step 9
ES–477
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
INSPECT PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the P1 park / neutral position switch
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between each terminal shown
below when the shift lever is moved to each position.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Shift Position
Tester Connection
Park/Neutral Position Switch
P
2 - 6, 4 - 5
R
1-2
N
2 - 9, 4 - 5
D
2-7
2
2-3
L
2-8
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
A093221E05
ES
(c) Reconnect the park / neutral position switch connector.
NG
REPLACE PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH - ECM)
5
INSPECT STARTER RELAY
(a) Remove the starter relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the starter relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E03
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
(c) Reinstall the starter relay.
NG
OK
Tester Connection
REPLACE STARTER RELAY
ES–478
6
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH - STARTER
RELAY, STARTER RELAY - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and the connector between the park /
neutral position switch connector and the starter relay.
(1) Disconnect the P1 park/neutral position switch
connector.
(2) Remove the starter relay from the engine room relay
block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
P1
ES
Tester Condition
Specified condition
Park/Neutral position switch (P1-5) Starter relay (1)
Below 1 Ω
Park/Neutral Position Switch Connector
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Engine Room R/B:
Starter Relay
A138162E01
Tester Condition
Specified condition
Park/Neutral position switch (P1-5)
or Starter relay (1) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the starter relay.
(5) Reconnect the park/neutral position switch.
(b) Check the harness and the connector between the
starter relay and the body ground.
(1) Remove the starter relay from the engine room relay
block.
(2) Measure the resistance between the starter relay
and the body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Condition
Specified condition
Starter relay (2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
7
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK (STARTER RELAY VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the Starter relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the voltage of the engine room relay block and
body ground.
Standard voltage
Engine Room R/B:
Starter
Relay
A072892E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Engine room relay block (Starter
relay terminal 5) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(c) Reinstall the Starter relay.
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (STARTER RELAY - BATTERY)
ES–479
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
8
INSPECT STARTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the starter assembly (See page ST-12).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STARTER ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (STARTER RELAY - STARTER, STARTER BATTERY)
ES
9
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Component Side: Ignition Switch
I18
IG1
ST2
ACC
4
8
AM1
3
7
AM2
Front View
2
6
ST1
1
5
(a) Remove the lower finish panel.
(b) Disconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the connector terminals
shown in the chart below.
Standard resistance
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
All terminals
10 kΩ or higher
ACC
2-3
ON
2-3
2 - 4, 6 - 7
START
1 - 2, 2 - 4
6 - 7, 6 - 8
IG2
A087913E10
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reconnect the I18 ignition switch connector.
NG
REPLACE IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (ECM - IGNITION SWITCH, IGNITION SWITCH BATTERY)
ES–480
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
IACV Control Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit opens and closes the Intake Air Control Valve (IACV) in response to the engine load in order to
increase the intake efficiency (ACIS: Acoustic Control Induction System).
When the engine speed is 4,700 rpm or more and the throttle valve opening angle is 60° or more, the
IACV is open (VSV: OFF). At all other times, the IACV is closed (VSV: ON).
IACV
IACV Closed (VSV: ON)
Intake
Manifold
Throttle Valve
Opening Angle (c)
ES
60
4,700
Engine Speed (rpm)
A054312E05
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
35
IC4
W-G
Engine Room R/B
J4
J/C
EFI No. 2
2
2
1
2
B
L-W
A
17
L-W
IC3
L-W
A
12
L-W
IM1
C
Engine Room R/B
3
5
1
2
2
V1
VSV (ACIS)
J28
J/C
C L-W
1
D
D
R
2
33
E4 ACIS
Engine Room R/B
EFI Relay
2
8
E8 MREL
W-G
2
EFI
L
2
2
2
2
1
W-B
B
B J2
J/C
B J3
W-B
EB
Battery
A133746E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–481
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE)
VSV is ON
Air
Port F
Port E
VSV is OFF
Air
Air
Filter
Port F
Port E
A067588E03
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from port F on the vacuum
switching valve (for ACIS).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / INTAKE CTL VSV1. Operate
the ACIS VSV.
(e) Check the VSV air flow when switching the VSV.
OK
Tester Condition
Specified Condition
VSV is ON
Air from port E flows out through port F
VSV is OFF
Air from port E flows out through the air filter
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK VACUUM HOSES (INTAKE MANIFOLD - VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE, VACUUM
SWITCHING VALVE - INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE)
(a) Check the condition of the vacuum hoses between the
intake manifold, vacuum switching valve (for ACIS) and
IACV.
(1) The vacuum hoses are connected securely.
(2) The vacuum hoses are not cracked or damaged.
OK:
The vacuum hoses are connected securely
and not cracked or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
OK
3
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Inspect the intake air control valve (See page IT-2).
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
ES
ES–482
4
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE (OPERATION)
(a) Check that air flows from port E to the air filter.
(b) Apply positive (+) battery voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
Air Filter
Air
NG
Port E
REPLACE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
ES
Air
Port E
Battery
Port F
A108114E01
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE - ECM, VACUUM
SWITCHING VALVE - EFI NO. 2 FUSE)
(a) Check the wire harness between the VSV for ACIS and
connector the ECM connector.
(1) Disconnect the V1 VSV for ACIS connector.
(2) Disconnect the E6 and E4 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
VSV for ACIS Connector
V1
Front View
E4
ACIS
E6
ECM Connector
E1
A115740E02
Tester Connection
Specified condition
VSV for ACIS (V1-2) - ACIS (E4-33)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified condition
VSV for ACIS (V1-2) or ACIS (E4-33) E1 (E6-1)
10 kΩ or higher
(b) Check the wire harness between the VSV for ACIS
connector and the EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the V1 VSV for ACIS connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room relay
block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
ES–483
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified condition
VSV for ACIS (V1-1) - EFI relay
terminal 3 of R/B
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–484
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) is used to indicate the ECM's detection of a vehicle malfunction.
The instrument panel GAUGE fuse provides the circuit with power and the ECM provides the circuit
ground that illuminates the MIL.
MIL operations should be checked visually:
The MIL should be illuminated when the ignition switch is turned ON. If the MIL is always ON or OFF, use
the intelligent tester and follow the procedures below to determine the cause of the problem.
If the ECM detects trouble, the MIL illuminates. At this time, the ECM records a DTC in the memory.
ES
ES–485
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
R
7
Engine
Room R/B
2
R-B
AM2
30
E7 W
ES
I18
Ignition Switch
2
7 C8
AM2
IG2
6
1
Malfunction
Indicator
Lamp
B-R
6 1D
2
Driver
Side J/B
GAUGE
B
15 C10
4 1G
Battery
Combination
Meter
R-L
A130726E01
ES–486
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THAT MILL IS ILLUMINATED
(a) Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the chart
below.
Condition
B
Proceed to
MIL remains ON
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
Go to step 5
A
ES
2
CHECK WHETHER MIL TURNS OFF
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with CAN VIM.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent tester
ON.
(c) Check whether any DTCs have been stored (See page
ES-48). Note them down if necessary.
(d) Clear the DTC (See page ES-35).
(e) Check if the MIL turns off.
OK:
MIL should turn off.
OK
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
(a) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check that the MIL is not illuminated.
OK:
MIL is not illuminated.
E7
OK
ECM Connector
REPLACE ECM
G035618E23
NG
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
(a) Check the harness and connector.
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION
METER
ES–487
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
5
CHECK THAT MIL IS ILLUMINATED
(a) Check that the MIL is illuminated when turning the
ignition switch ON.
OK:
MIL is illuminated.
OK
SYSTEM OK
ES
NG
6
CHECK THAT ENGINE STARTS
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Start the engine.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Engine starts
A
Engine does not start*
B
HINT:
*: The intelligent tester cannot communicate with the
ECM.
B
GO TO VC OUTPUT CIRCUIT
A
7
INSPECT COMBINATION METER (MIL CIRCUIT)
(a) See the combination meter troubleshooting section (See
page ME-4).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION
METER
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
ES–488
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-81)
3.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
4.
REMOVE OIL COOLER PIPE (See page EM-85)
5.
REMOVE TIMING BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY NO.
3 LH (See page EM-85)
6.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolt, stud bolt and camshaft position
sensor.
ES
A134404
INSTALLATION
A134404
1.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install the camshaft position sensor with the bolt and
stud bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Reconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL TIMING BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY NO.
3 LH (See page EM-90)
3.
INSTALL OIL COOLER PIPE (See page EM-90)
4.
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
5.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
6.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
7.
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-92)
ES–492
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
REMOVAL
B003153
ES
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
2.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crank position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and crankshaft position sensor.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–493
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance:
Cold:
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot:
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" above mean the temperature
of the coils themselves. "Cold" is from -10°C
(14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C
(122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSTALLATION
B003153
1.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install crank position sensor with bolt.
Torque: 6.5 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 58 in.*lbf)
(b) Reconnect the crank position sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
ES
ES–496
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and throttle body cover subassembly.
3.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hoses (for the P/S idle-up
and fuel pressure regulator) and ventilation hose.
(b) Remove the air cleaner hose assembly.
4.
REMOVE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the water by-pass hose, water by-pass
hose No. 7 and the throttle position sensor
connector.
ES
A133759
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and nut.
(c) Remove the throttle body and the throttle body
gasket.
A133760
Ohmmeter
INSPECTION
M-
1.
M+
INSPECT THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the throttle control motor connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the motor resistance
between terminals M+ and M-.
Motor resistance:
0.3 to 100 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
A133758E01
INSTALLATION
1.
A133760
INSPECT THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the throttle body with the 3
bolts and nut.
Torque: 14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES–497
(b) Connect the water by-pass hose, water by-pass
hose No. 7 and throttle position sensor connector.
A133759
2.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
3.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
4.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
5.
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the throttle body cover sub-assembly with the
2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
ES
ES–500
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
REMOVAL
ES
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-6)
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
3.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and throttle body cover subassembly.
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hoses (for the power
steering idle-up and fuel pressure regulator) and
ventilation hose.
(b) Remove the air cleaner hose assembly.
5.
DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE (See page FU-10)
6.
DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE NO.2 (See page EM-82)
7.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS FROM INTAKE
MANIFOLD
(a) Disconnect the throttle control connector.
(b) Disconnect the purge VSV.
(c) Disconnect the 8 injector connectors.
(d) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(e) Disconnect the 2 VSV connectors for the air
injection system.
(f) Disconnect the 8 ignition coil connectors.
(g) Disconnect the 2 air fuel ratio sensor connectors.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
8.
[B]
ES–501
DISCONNECT HOSES FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose [A] from the fuel
pressure regulator.
(b) Disconnect the PCV hoses [B] from the PCV valve
on the LH cylinder head.
(c) Disconnect the EVAP hose (from the charcoal
canister) [C] from the purge VSV.
(d) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses [D] from the VSV
for the air injection system.
[A]
ES
[C]
[D]
A134405E01
9.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Disconnect the 2 water by-pass hoses from the
throttle body.
Water By-pass Hose
A133761E01
(b) Disconnect the 2 wire clamps from the wire clamp
bracket on the RH delivery pipe.
A133763
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–39
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
NOTICE:
• If no DTC appears in normal mode:
On the OBD II scan tool or the intelligent tester, check
the pending fault code using the Continuous Test
Results function (Mode 7 for SAE J1979).
• When the diagnosis system is changed from normal
mode to check mode or vice versa, all DTCs and
freeze frame data recorded in normal mode are
erased. Before changing modes, always check and
make a note of DTCs and freeze frame data.
HINT:
• DTCs stored in the ECM can be displayed on the
intelligent tester. The intelligent tester can display current
and pending DTCs.
• The some DTCs are not set if the ECM does not detect the
same malfunction again during a second consecutive
driving cycle. However, malfunctions detected on only one
occasion are stored as pending DTCs.
Intelligent Tester
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
A072434E01
2.
CHECK DTC (Using the intelligent tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT
CODES.
(e) Check the DTC(s) and freeze frame data, and then
write them down.
(f) Check the details of the DTC(s) (See page ES-48).
NOTICE:
• When simulating a symptom with the OBD II
scan tool (excluding intelligent tester) to
check the DTCs, use the normal mode. For
DTCs subject to "2 trip detection logic",
perform either of the following actions.
• Turn the ignition switch to OFF after the
symptom is simulated once. Then repeat the
simulation process again. When the problem
has been simulated again, the MIL illuminates
and the DTCs are recorded in the ECM.
• Check the pending fault code using the
Continuous Test Results function (Mode 7 for
SAE J1979) on the OBD II scan tool.
FREEZE FRAME DATA (Using the OBD II scan tool or
intelligent tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or intelligent tester to
the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
ES
ES–40
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3.
ES
4.
(c) Use the OBD II scan tool or intelligent tester to
check the DTCs and freeze frame data and then
write them down. For the intelligent tester, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
FREEZE FRAME DATA. For the OBD II scan tool,
see its instruction manual.
CLEAR DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or intelligent
tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or the intelligent tester
to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Erase DTCs and freeze frame data with the OBD II
scan tool (complying with SAE J1978) or the
intelligent tester For the intelligent tester: 1) enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES; and 2) press
YES. For the OBD II scan tool, see its instruction
manual.
CLEAR DTC (Not using the OBD II scan tool or
intelligent tester)
(a) Remove the EFI and ETCS fuse from the engine
room R/B for more than 60 seconds, or disconnect
the battery terminal for more than 60 seconds.
When disconnecting the battery terminal, perform
the "INITIALIZE" procedure.
ES–502
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
(c) Remove the bolt and nut holding the engine wire
protector from the intake manifold and cylinder
head.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and ground cables from the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
(e) Remove the bolt and V-bank cover bracket from the
intake manifold.
A133764
(f)
Disconnect the engine wire from the engine hanger
and wire bracket.
ES
A133765
(g) Remove the bolt and wire bracket from the intake
manifold.
(h) Remove the 6 bolts, 4 nuts, intake manifold
assembly and 2 gaskets.
10. REMOVE AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY W/ BRACKET (See
page EC-11)
A133766
11. REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and 2 knock sensors.
A133767
INSPECTION
1.
Ohmmeter
A093606E07
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (Ground) - 2 (Output)
120 to 280 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
knock sensor.
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–503
INSTALLATION
Knock Sensor 2
1.
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Install the 2 knock sensors with the 2 nuts as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
2.
INSTALL AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY W/ BRACKET (See
page EC-12)
Upper
Engine
Rear
0° to 10°
ES
Engine
Rear
Upper
0° to 10°
Knock Sensor 1
A133768E01
3.
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Place 2 new gaskets on the intake manifold.
A133769
(b) Place the intake manifold on the cylinder heads.
(c) Install and uniformly tighten the 6 bolts and 4 nuts in
several steps.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
A133770
ES–504
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
(d) Install the V-bank cover bracket to the intake
manifold.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the wire bracket to the intake manifold with
the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(f) Connect the engine wire to the engine hanger and
wire bracket.
A133771
(g) Connect the wire protector to the intake manifold
and cylinder heads with the bolt and nut.
(h) Install the 2 ground cables with the 2 bolts to the RH
and LH cylinder heads.
ES
A133764
(i)
Connect the 2 water by-pass hoses to the throttle
body.
(j)
Connect the 2 wire clamps to the wire clamp bracket
on the RH delivery pipe.
A133761
Wire Clamp
A133763E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
4.
CONNECT HOSES FORM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Connect the vacuum hose [A] to the fuel pressure
regulator.
(b) Connect the PCV hose [B] to the PCV valve on the
LH cylinder head.
(c) Connect the EVAP hose (from the charcoal canister)
[C] to the purge VSV.
(d) Connect the 2 vacuum hoses [D] to the VSV for the
air injection system.
5.
CONNECT CONNECTORS FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Connect the throttle control connector.
(b) Connect the 2 VSV connectors for the air injection
system.
(c) Connect the purge VSV connector.
(d) Connect the 8 injector connectors.
(e) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
(f) Connect the 8 ignition coil connectors.
(g) Connect the 2 air fuel ratio sensor connectors.
[D]
[A]
[C]
[B]
A134405E02
ES–505
6.
INSTALL FUEL HOSE NO.2
7.
INSTALL FUEL HOSE (See page FU-13)
8.
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
9.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
10. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
11. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-5)
ES
ES–494
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
THROTTLE BODY
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
WATER BY-PASS HOSE
ES
VACUUM HOSE
IDLE UP NO. 2
HOSE
THROTTLE
BODY GASKET
14 (143, 10)
VENTILATION
HOSE
AIR CLEANER HOSE
ASSEMBLY
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE NO. 7
THROTTLE W/MOTOR
BODY ASSEMBLY
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR CONNECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119859E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES–495
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
A133757
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
(a) Check for an operating sound.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) When turning the accelerator pedal position
sensor lever, listen to a running sound of the
motor. Also, check that there is no friction
sound.
If operation is not as specified, check the
throttle control motor (See page ES-496),
wiring and ECM.
(b) Inspect the throttle position sensor.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) When turning the accelerator pedal position
sensor lever to the full-open position, check the
throttle valve opening percentage (THROTTLE
POS) of the CURRENT DATA.
Standard throttle valve opening percentage:
60% or more
If the result is not as specified, check the
accelerator pedal position sensor (See page
ES-353), wiring and ECM.
If the intelligent tester is not available, measure
the voltage between the terminals (VTA1 - E2,
VTA2 - E2) of the ECM connector (See page
ES-27).
(c) Inspect the air assist system.
(1) Start the engine and check that the MIL does
not light up.
(2) Warm up the engine to the normal operating
temperature.
(3) Switch the A/C compressor from ON to OFF,
and check the idle speed.
Idle speed (Transmission in neutral):
700 +- 50 rpm
NOTICE:
Perform this inspection while no electrical
load is applied.
(d) Perform the driving test.
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–41
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Compared to normal mode, check mode is more sensitive to
malfunctions. Therefore, check mode can detect the
malfunctions that cannot be detected by normal mode.
NOTICE:
All the stored DTCs and freeze frame data are erased if:
1) the ECM is changed from normal mode to check mode
or vice versa; or 2) the ignition switch is turned from ON
to ACC or OFF while in check mode. Before changing
modes, always check and make a note of any DTCs and
freeze frame data.
1. CHECK MODE PROCEDURE (Using the intelligent
tester)
(a) Check and ensure the following conditions:
(1) Positive (+) battery voltage of 11 V or more.
(2) Throttle valve fully closed.
(3) Transmission in the P or N position.
(4) A/C switch OFF.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn the tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / CHECK MODE.
(g) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode.
0.13 seconds
ON
OFF
2.
0.13 seconds
A076900E08
3.
(h) Make sure the MIL flashes as shown in the
illustration.
(i) Start the engine.
(j) Make sure the MIL turns OFF.
(k) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described
by the customer.
(l) Check DTCs and freeze frame data using the tester.
CLEAR DTC (Using the intelligent tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Erase DTCs and freeze frame data with the OBD II
scan tool (complying with SAE J1978) or the
intelligent tester. For the intelligent tester: 1) enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES; and 2) press
YES.
CLEAR DTC (Not using the intelligent tester)
(a) Remove the EFI and ETCS fuse from the engine
room R/B for more than 60 seconds, or disconnect
the battery terminal for more than 60 seconds.
When disconnecting the battery terminal, perform
the "INITIALIZE" procedure.
ES
ES–42
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
HINT:
If any of the following codes are recorded, the ECM enters
the fail-safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail-Safe Operation
Fail-Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0031, P0032, P0037,
P0038, P0051, P0052,
P0057 and P0058
The heater circuit in which an abnormality is detected is
turned off
Ignition switch OFF
P0100, P0102 and P0103
Ignition timing is calculated from engine RPM and TP
(Throttle Position)
"Pass" condition detected
P0110, P0112 and P0113
IAT (Intake Air Temperature) is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
"Pass" condition detected
P0115, P0117 and P0118
ECT (Engine Coolant Temperature) is fixed at 80°C
(176°F)
"Pass" condition detected
P0120, P0121, P0122,
P0123, P0220, P0222,
P0223, P2102, P2103,
P2111, P2112, P2118,
P2119 and P2135
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a
malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a
predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the
engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance
with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the
vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly,
the vehicle can be driven slowly. If the accelerator pedal
is depressed quickly, the vehicle may speed up and
slow down erratically.
"Pass" condition detected and then the ignition switch
turned OFF
P0327, P0328, P0332 and
P0333
Maximum ignition timing retardation
Ignition switch OFF
P0351, P0352, P0353,
P0354, P0355, P0356,
P0357 and P0358
Fuel is cut
"Pass" condition detected
P2120, P2121, P2122,
P2123, P2125, P2127,
P2128 and P2138
The accelerator pedal position sensor has two (main
and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in
either of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the
abnormal signal voltage difference between the two
sensor circuits and switches to limp mode. In limp
mode, the functioning circuit is used to calculate the
accelerator pedal opening angle to allow the vehicle to
continue driving. If both circuits malfunction, the ECM
regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to
be fully closed. In this case, the throttle valve will
remain closed as if the engine is idling.
"Pass" condition detected and then the ignition switch
turned OFF
P2440 and P1441 and/or
P1444
Restrict the throttle opening angle: Ga is 30, 50, 100 g/
sec. or less
"Pass" condition detected
P1441 and P1444
Restrict the throttle opening angle: Ga is 30, 50, 100 g/
sec. or less
"Pass" condition detected
P1441 and P1444
Restrict the throttle opening angle: Ga is 30, 50, 100 g/
sec. or less
"Pass" condition detected
P2430, P2431, P2432 and
P2433
Restrict the throttle opening angle: Ga is 30, 50, 100 g/
sec. or less
"Pass" condition detected
ES
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–497
KNOCK SENSOR
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
ES
IDLE UP NO. 2 HOSE
VACUUM HOSE
VENTILATION HOSE
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119860E01
ES–498
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ENGINE WIRE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ES
ENGINE WIRE
VSV FOR AIR
INJECTION
SYSTEM
18 (185, 13)
INJECTOR CONNECTOR
18 (185, 13)
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
FUEL RETURN HOSE
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE NO. 7
FUEL HOSE
INTAKE MANIFOLD
FUEL PIPE CLAMP NO. 2
FUEL PIPE CLAMP NO. 1
VSV CONNECTOR FOR EVAP
GASKET
VACUUM HOSE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
WIRE BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
ENGINE WIRE
Non-reusable part
A119820E04
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–499
18 (185, 13)
WATER BY-PASS PIPE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
16 (163, 12)
ES
16 (163, 12)
O-RING
AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY W/ BRACKET
20 (204, 15)
KNOCK SENSOR 1
20 (204, 15)
KNOCK SENSOR 2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A130716E01
ES–510
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2 (See page IP-9)
2.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-9)
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO.2 (See page IP-9)
4.
REMOVE ECM
(a) Disconnect the 5 ECM connector.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and ECM.
(c) Remove the 2 screws and ECM bracket No. 1 from
the ECM.
(d) Remove the 2 screws and ECM bracket No. 2 from
the ECM.
ES
A072553
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ECM
(a) Install the ECM bracket No. 2 with the 2 screws to
the ECM.
(b) Install the ECM bracket No. 1 with the 2 screws to
ECM.
(c) Install the ECM with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(d) Connect the 5 ECM connector.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO.2
3.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
A072553
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ACCELERATOR PEDAL
ES–513
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• Be care not to give a shock to the accelerator
pedal assembly.
• Be care not to disassemble the accelerator pedal
assembly.
(a) Install the accelerator pedal assembly with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect a accelerator pedal connector.
ES
A067127
ES–505
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – EFI RELAY
EFI RELAY
Ohmmeter
1
2
INSPECTION
1.
5
3
Battery
A123026E02
INSPECT EFI RELAY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the E.F.I
relay.
ES
ES–506
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
Ohmmeter
1
2
1.
5
3
Battery
A123026E02
ES
INSPECTION
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
circuit opening relay.
ES–507
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – FUEL PUMP RELAY
FUEL PUMP RELAY
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RELAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance
Tester Connection
Battery
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuel
pump relay.
A094494E01
ES
ES–508
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ECM
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ES
ECM
A119840E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ES–509
ES
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL LOWER NO.2
GLOVE COMPARTMENT
DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
B120192E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ACCELERATOR PEDAL
ES–511
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ES
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
(ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR)
A119840E02
ES–512
2UZ-FE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ACCELERATOR PEDAL
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
ES
INSPECT ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check if the voltage (ACCEL POS) of the
CURRENT DATA indicates the standard value.
Accelerator pedal released:
0.5 to 1.1 V
Accelerator pedal depressed:
2.6 to 4.5 V
(d) Check if the voltage (ACCEL POS #2) of the
CURRENT DATA indicates the standard value.
Accelerator pedal released:
1.2 to 2.0 V
Accelerator pedal depressed:
3.4 to 5.3 V
If the intelligent tester is not available, measure the
voltage between the terminals (VPA - EPA, VPA2 EPA2) of the ECM connector (See page ES-27).
REMOVAL
1.
A067127
REMOVE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect a accelerator pedal connector.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and accelerator pedal assembly.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
EM–7
INSPECTION
1.
P/S
Pump
INSTALLATION
No. 2 Idler
Tensioner
1.
No. 1 Idler
Generator
Crankshaft
INSPECT V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the V belt from the tensioner pulley. Then
check that nothing gets caught the tensioner by
turning it clockwise and counterclockwise.
(b) When a malfunction exists, replace the tensioner.
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
(a) Set the V belt onto every parts except the No. 2 idler
pulley, as shown in the illustration.
(b) Loosen the V belt by turning the belt tensioner
counterclockwise.
(c) Set the V belt to the No. 2 idler pulley.
A/C Compressor
A053117E01
A
C
B
A052038E01
(d) After installing a new belt, check that the mark is
within the B range as shown in the illustration.
EM
EM–16
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
REMOVAL
Oil Cooler
Hose
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
SEPARATE BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
3.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and throttle body cover subassembly.
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support seal
upper.
6.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
7.
REMOVE FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Unfasten each clip and the 2 hose clamps, and then
separate the 2 oil cooler hoses from the fan shroud.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and separate the fan shroud
from the radiator.
(c) Remove the 4 nuts and separate the fan with fluid
coupling from the engine.
(d) Remove the fan shroud and fan with fluid coupling
together from the vehicle.
(e) Remove the fan pulley.
8.
SEPARATE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose.
(b) Remove the nut, 2 bolts and vane pump assembly.
HINT:
Hang up the hoses instead of detaching.
9.
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CH-10)
EM
Hose Clamp
A070463E01
A134361
10. SEPARATE COMPRESSOR
(a) Disconnect the compressor connector.
(b) Remove the nut, 3 bolts, compressor stay and
compressor.
HINT:
Hang up the hoses instead of detaching.
A134362
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
EM–17
11. REMOVE NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the pulley bolt, cover plate and idler pulley.
12. REMOVE OIL COOLER PIPE
(a) Disconnect the 3 hoses.
(b) Remove the bolt, nut and oil cooler pipe.
A072691
13. REMOVE NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the grommet and separate the cam
position sensor connector from the No. 3 timing belt
cover sub-assembly LH.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 3 timing belt cover subassembly LH.
14. REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
(a) Remove the nut, 3 bolts and No. 2 timing belt cover.
A014424
15. REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 timing belt cover subassembly.
16. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and V-ribbed belt tensioner.
17. REMOVE FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, 2 bolts and fan bracket subassembly.
18. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-70011 (09213-70020), 09330-00021
SST
A054468E02
(b) Using SST, remove the crankshaft pulley.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05021)
SST
A054470E02
EM
EM–18
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
19. REMOVE TIMING BELT NO. 1 COVER
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
A072694
20. REMOVE NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
PLATE
(a) Remove the No. 1 crankshaft position sensor plate.
EM
A072696
21. REMOVE TIMING BELT
(a) If reusing the timing belt, check the installation
marks on the timing belt.
(1) Check that there are 3 installation marks on the
timing belt by turning the crankshaft as shown
in the illustration.
If the installation marks have disappeared, put
a new installation mark on the timing belt
before removing each part.
A054457
(b) Set the No. 1 cylinder to approx. 50° BTDC/
compression.
(1) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft to align the timing marks of the
crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
Turn
A054456E01
(2) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft
timing pulleys and timing belt plates are
aligned.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°).
A054458
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
Approx. 50°
Turn
Timing Mark
A054461E04
EM–19
(3) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft counterclockwise by approx. 50°.
NOTICE:
If the timing belt is disengaged, having the
crankshaft pulley at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to
come into contact with each other when
removing the camshaft timing pulley and
camshaft, causing damage. So always set
the crankshaft pulley at the correct angle.
(c) Alternately loosen the 2 bolts, then remove the
bolts, the chain tensioner and dust boot.
EM
A072697
(d) Using a SST, loosen the tension between the
camshaft timing pulley (RH bank) and crankshaft
timing pulley by turning the camshaft timing pulley
(RH bank) counterclockwise slightly.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00350)
(e) Disconnect the timing belt from the No. 1 timing belt
idler and remove the timing belt.
SST
Slightly
Turn
A054459E02
EM–20
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
INSTALLATION
1.
Drain Hole
Air Hole
EM
A053991E01
1 Tooth
1/2 Teeth
A139497E01
INSTALL TIMING BELT
(a) Check the No. 1 timing belt idler and No. 2 timing
belt idler.
(1) Visually check the seal portion of the idler
pulley for oil leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the idler.
(2) Check that the idler turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler.
(b) Check the water pump.
(1) Visually check the air hole and water hole for
coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump and
timing belt.
(2) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump
bearing moves smoothly.
If necessary, replace the water pump.
(c) Remove any oil or water on the crankshaft pulley, oil
pump pulley, water pump pulley, No. 1 idler and No.
2 idler, and keep them clean.
NOTICE:
Only wipe the pulleys; do not use any cleansing
agent.
(d) Set the No. 1 cylinder to the TDC/compression.
(1) Turn the hexagonal portion of the camshaft to
align the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys and timing belt plates.
HINT:
By turning the camshaft timing pulleys
clockwise as follows, installation of the timing
pulleys will be easy:
1/2 teeth turn for the left bank camshaft timing
pulley
1 tooth turn for the right bank camshaft timing
pulley
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
EM–21
(2) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft to align the timing marks of the
crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
Turn
A054465E01
A054463
(e) Install the timing belt.
(1) Remove any oil or water on each pulley, and
keep them clean.
NOTICE:
Only wipe the pulleys; do not use any
cleansing agent.
(2) Face the front mark (arrow) on the timing belt
forward.
(3) Put the timing belt on the crankshaft timing
pulley.
• Align the installation mark on the timing belt
with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing
pulley.
(4) Put the timing belt on the No. 2 idler.
(5) Put the timing belt on the camshaft timing
pulley (LH bank).
• Align the installation mark on the timing belt
with the timing mark of the camshaft timing
pulley.
(6) Put the timing belt on the water pump pulley.
(7) Put the timing belt on the camshaft timing
pulley (RH bank).
• Align the installation mark on the timing belt
with the timing mark of the camshaft timing
pulley.
(8) Put the timing belt on the No. 1 idler.
(f)
1.27 mm Hexagon Wrench
A054983E02
Set the belt tensioner.
(1) Using a press, slowly press in the push rod
using 981 to 9,807 N (100 to 1,000 kgf, 220 to
2,205 lbf) of pressure.
(2) Align the holes of the push rod and housing,
and pass a 1.27 mm hexagon wrench through
the holes to keep the setting position of the
push rod.
(3) Release the press.
(4) Install the dust boot to the belt tensioner.
EM
EM–22
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
(g) Install the belt tensioner.
(1) Temporarily install the belt tensioner with the 2
bolts.
(2) Alternately tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 26 N*m (270 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
(3) Using pliers, remove the 1.27 mm hexagon
wrench from the chain tensioner.
1.27 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
A054462E02
(h) Check the valve timing.
(1) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, slowly turn
the crankshaft pulley 2 revolutions from the
TDC to TDC.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft pulley
clockwise.
EM
Turn
A054456E01
(2) Check that each pulley is aligned with each
timing mark as shown in the illustration.
If the timing marks are not aligned, remove the
timing belt and reinstall it.
(3) Remove the crankshaft damper bolt.
A054458
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
PLATE
(a) Install the sensor plate as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Take care not to install it in a wrong direction.
3.
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO. 1 COVER
(a) Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
Front
A053994E01
A072694
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
4.
SST
EM–23
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the
crankshaft damper.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the crankshaft
damper.
SST 09223-46011
A054471E02
(c) Using SST, install the damper bolt.
SST 09213-70011 (09213-70020), 09330-00021
Torque: 245 N*m (2,498 kgf*cm, 181 ft.*lbf)
SST
EM
A054469E02
5.
INSTALL FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the idler pulley with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: For 12 mm head
16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
For 14 mm head
32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
106 mm (4.17 in.) for 12 mm head (A)
114 mm (4.49 in.) for 14 mm head (B)
6.
INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the belt tensioner with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use a bolt 106 mm (4.17 in.) in length.
7.
INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the timing belt cover and fit the claws and
pins into each part.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use bolts 106 mm (4.17 in.) in length.
B
A
A134365E03
A072692
A054467
EM–24
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
8.
INSTALL NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the timing belt cover sub-assembly with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the camshaft position sensor connector and
grommet to the timing belt cover.
9.
INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
(a) Install the timing chain or belt cover with the nut and
3 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
10. INSTALL OIL COOLER PIPE
(a) Install the oil cooler pipe with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 3 hoses.
11. INSTALL NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the idler pulley and cover plate with the bolt.
Torque: 39 N*m (398 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
EM
12. INSTALL COMPRESSOR
(a) Install the compressor with the stay, nut and 3 bolts.
Torque: Bolt
47 N*m (475 kgf*cm, 34 ft.*lbf)
Nut
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
A072691
13. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CH-17)
14. INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the vane pump assembly with the nut and 2
bolts.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
15. INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Install the fan pulley to the engine.
(b) Put the fan with fluid coupling and fan shroud
together into the engine room.
(c) Install the fan shroud with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the fan with fluid coupling with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
16. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
17. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
18. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
19. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the throttle body cover sub-assembly with the
2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
20. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
21. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
EM–1
ENGINE
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-1)
2.
INSPECT ENGINE OIL (See page LU-1)
3.
INSPECT BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY (See page
CH-3)
4.
INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUBASSEMBLY
5.
INSPECT FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
HINT:
As the belt tensioner coordinates belt tension
automatically by its mechanism, you do not need to
adjust it by yourself.
(a) Check that the indicator mark on the automatic
tensioner is within the A range as shown in the
illustration.
(b) When the mark is out of the standard range, replace
the V belt with a new one.
A
C
B
6.
INSPECT V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-6)
7.
WARM UP ENGINE
8.
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
(a) When using the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool:
(1) Connect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool to the DLC3.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool operator's manual for further details.
Ignition timing:
5 to 15° BTDC at idle (Transmission in
neutral)
(2) Disconnect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool from the DLC3.
A052038E01
Intelligent
Tester
1
DLC3
A134356E01
(b) When not using the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool:
(1) Remove the V-bank cover.
(2) Connect the tester probe of a timing light to the
wire of the ignition coil connector for the No. 1
cylinder.
A072742
EM
EM–2
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
TAC
(3) Using SST, connect the tachometer probe to
terminal TAC of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18030
Tachometer
SST
DLC3
Battery
A075820E01
(4) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of
the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
CG
TC
EM
DLC3
A075821E01
(5) Using the timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing:
5 to 15° BTDC at idle (Transmission in
neutral)
(6) Remove the SST from the DLC3.
(7) Disconnect the timing light from the engine.
(8) Install the V-bank cover.
A004459
Intelligent
Tester
1
DLC3
A134356E01
9.
INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED
(a) When using the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool:
(1) Connect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool to the DLC3.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool operator's manual for further details.
(2) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90
seconds.
(3) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed:
700 +- 50 rpm
If the idle speed is not as specified, check the
air intake system.
(4) Disconnect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool from the DLC3.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
TAC
DLC3
Tachometer
SST
Battery
A075820E01
EM–3
(b) When not using the intelligent tester or OBD II scan
tool:
(1) Using SST, connect the tachometer probe to
terminal TAC of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18030
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
(2) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90
seconds.
(3) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed:
700 +- 50 rpm
(4) Remove the SST from the DLC3.
(5) Disconnect the tachometer from the DLC3.
10. INSPECT COMPRESSION
(a) Remove the V-bank cover sub-assembly.
(b) Remove the air cleaner hose assembly.
(c) Disconnect the throttle control motor connector.
(d) Remove the 8 ignition coils.
(e) Remove the 8 spark plugs.
(f) Disconnect the 8 injector connectors.
A074993
(g) Inspect the cylinder compression pressure.
(1) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug
hole (Procedure "A").
(2) Fully open the throttle forcibly by hand.
(3) While cranking the engine, measure the
compression pressure (Procedure "B").
HINT:
Always use a fully charged battery to obtain an
engine speed of 250 rpm or more.
(4) Repeat procedures "A" to "B" for each cylinder.
NOTICE:
This measurement must be done as quickly
as possible.
Compression pressure:
1,373 kPa (14.0 kgf/cm2, 199 psi) or more
Minimum pressure:
1,030 kPa (10.5 kgf/cm2, 149 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) or less
(5) If the cylinder compression in one or more
cylinders is low, pour a small amount of engine
oil into the cylinder through the spark plug hole
and repeat procedures "A" to "B" for the
cylinders with low compression.
• If adding oil helps the compression, the
piston rings and/or cylinder bore may be
worn or damaged.
• If pressure stays low, a valve may be
sticking, seating is improper, or there may
be leakage past the gasket.
(h) Connect the 8 injector connectors.
EM
EM–4
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Install the 8 spark plugs.
Install the 8 ignition coils.
Connect the throttle control motor connector.
Install the air cleaner hose assembly.
Install the V-bank cover sub-assembly.
11. INSPECT CO/HC
HINT:
This check is used only to determine whether or not the
idle CO/ HC complies with regulations.
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Sustain the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx.
180 seconds.
EM
A070520
CO
HC
Symptom
(c) Insert the CO/HC meter testing probe at least 40 cm
(1.3 ft) into the tailpipe during idling.
(d) Immediately check CO/HC concentration at idle
and/or 2,500 rpm.
HINT:
When performing the 2 mode (2,500 rpm and idle)
test, follow the measurement order prescribed by
the applicable local regulations.
If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with
the regulations, troubleshoot in the order given
below.
(1) Check the heated oxygen sensor operation
(See page ES-135 and ES-364).
(2) See the table below for possible causes, then
inspect and correct the applicable causes if
necessary.
Cause
Normal
High
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignitions:
– Incorrect timing
– Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaky intake and exhaust valves
4. Leaky cylinder
Low
High
Rough idle
(Fluctuating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
– PCV hose
– Intake manifold
– Throttle body
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
High
High
Rough idle
Black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Faulty SFI system:
– Faulty pressure regulator
– Defective ECT sensor
– Faulty ECM
– Faulty injector
– Faulty throttle position sensor
– Faulty MAF sensor
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
EM–27
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TIMING BELT
HINT:
(See page EM-18)
2.
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 4 ignition coil connectors.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and 4 ignition coils.
3.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER (for RH Side)
(a) Remove the 9 bolts, 9 seal washers, cylinder head
cover and gasket.
4.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER (for LH Side)
(a) Remove the 9 bolts, 9 seal washers, cylinder head
cover and gasket. Remove the cylinder head cover.
5.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Hold the camshaft with a wrench, and remove the 4
bolts and timing pulley.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the 4 bolts shown in the
illustration. If any of them are loosened or
removed, the backlash of the gear in the timing
tube will go out of adjustment. In this case,
replace the timing tube assembly with a new
one.
6.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Hold the camshaft with a wrench, and remove the 4
bolts and timing pulley.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the 4 bolts shown in the
illustration. If any of them are loosened or
removed, the backlash of the gear in the timing
tube will go out of adjustment. In this case,
replace the timing tube assembly with a new
one.
A070489
EM
A066672
Do not remove
A134392E01
Do not remove
A134395E01
EM–28
EM
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
Cut Part
7.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt, stud bolt and camshaft position
sensor.
8.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (for RH Side)
NOTICE:
• As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small,
the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the
portion of the cylinder head which receives the
shaft thrust may crack or be damaged. To avoid
this, the following steps should be carried out.
• Having the crankshaft pulley at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to come
into contact with each other when removing the
camshaft. Always set the crankshaft pulley at the
correct angle as shown in the illustration.
Crankshaft pulley
45°
Matchmarks
A134393E01
(a) Bring the service bolt hole of the sub-gear upward
by turning the hexagonal portion of the exhaust
camshaft with a wrench.
(b) Secure the sub-gear to the main gear with a service
bolt.
Recommended service bolt
Service Bolt
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm
A054025E01
HINT:
When removing the camshafts, make sure that the
torsional spring force of the sub-gear has been
eliminated by the above operation.
(c) Set the timing mark (1-dot mark) of the camshaft
main gear at approx. 10° angle by turning the
hexagonal portion of the exhaust camshaft with a
wrench.
Approx.
10°
A054026E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
2
17
18
15
13
14
8
4
10
9
7
12
11
21
20
19
6
16
(d) Uniformly loosen and remove the 22 bearing cap
bolts in several steps, in the order shown in the
illustration.
(e) Remove the oil feed pipe, 9 bearing caps, camshaft
housing plug, oil control valve filter, and camshafts.
HINT:
Arrange the bearing caps in the correct order.
22
5
3
EM–29
1
A054151E01
(f)
Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
• Do not remove the 4 bolts shown in the
illustration. If any of them are loosened or
removed, the backlash of the gear in the
timing tube will go out of adjustment. In this
case, replace the timing tube assembly with a
new one.
(g) Remove the screw plug and seal washer.
Do not remove
A054961E02
(h) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the bolt.
(i) Pull out the timing tube and drive gear from the
camshaft.
10 mm Hexagon
Wrench
A054031E02
(j)
5 mm Hexagon
Wrench
9.
SST
A054029E02
Using SST and a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove
the 4 bolts, drive gear and oil seal.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing tube.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (for LH Side)
NOTICE:
• As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small,
the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the
portion of the cylinder head which receives the
shaft thrust may crack or be damaged. To avoid
this, the following steps should be carried out.
• Having the crankshaft pulley at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to come
into contact with each other when removing the
camshaft. Always set the crankshaft pulley at the
correct angle as shown in the illustration.
EM
EM–30
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
(a) Bring the service bolt hole of the sub-gear upward
by turning the hexagonal portion of the exhaust
camshaft with a wrench.
(b) Secure the sub-gear to the main gear with a service
bolt.
Recommended service bolt
Service Bolt
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm
A054037E01
HINT:
When removing the camshafts, make sure that the
torsional spring force of the sub-gear has been
eliminated by the above operation.
(c) Align the timing marks (2-dot marks) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears by turning the hexagonal
portion of the exhaust camshaft with a wrench.
Align
EM
B002650E01
21
2
22
5
20
19
1
17
15
6
13
18
4
16
12
3
14
10
11
9
(d) Uniformly loosen and remove the 22 bearing cap
bolts in several steps, in the order shown in the
illustration.
(e) Remove the oil feed pipe, 9 bearing caps, camshaft
housing plug, oil control valve filter, and camshafts.
HINT:
Arrange the bearing caps in the correct order.
8
7
A054154E01
(f)
Do not remove
A054961E02
Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
• Do not remove the 4 bolts shown in the
illustration. If any of them are loosened or
removed, the backlash of the gear in the
timing tube will go out of adjustment. In this
case, replace the timing tube assembly with a
new one.
(g) Remove the screw plug and seal washer.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
EM–31
(h) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the bolt.
(i) Pull out the timing tube and drive gear assembly
from the camshaft.
10 mm Hexagon
Wrench
A054031E02
(j)
5 mm Hexagon
Wrench
Using SST and a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove
the 4 bolts, drive gear and oil seal.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing tube.
10. REMOVE SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
SST
EM
A054029E02
11. REMOVE CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A002859
(b) Using SST, turn the sub gear clockwise and remove
the service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
Service Bolt
Turn
SST
A002850E02
(c) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(d) Remove the wave washer, sub gear and gear
spring.
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft sub gears and gear spring
(RH and LH sides).
A054970
EM–32
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
(e) Using a vernier caliper, measure the gap distance of
the gear spring.
Gap distance:
18.2 to 18.8 mm (0.717 to 0.740 in.)
If the gap distance is not as specified, replace the
gear spring.
18.2 to 18.8 mm
12. REMOVE CAMSHAFT HOUSING PLUG
A053870E01
INSTALLATION
1.
[1]
[2]
Pin
[3]
EM
INSTALL CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Install the gear spring [1], sub gear [2] and wave
washer [3].
HINT:
Attach the pins on the gears to the gear spring ends.
Pin
A054971E01
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
A002861
(c) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A002859
Service Bolt
Sub Gear
Main Gear
SST
Turn
A002889E03
(d) Using SST, align the holes of the driven main gear
and sub gear by turning the sub gear clockwise.
Temporarily install a service bolt.
(e) Align the gear teeth of the driven main gear and sub
gear, and tighten the service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
2.
EM–33
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert a new oil seal into the camshaft timing tube
until it reaches the stopper.
NOTICE:
• Be careful of the installation direction.
• Do not turn over the oil seal lip.
Front
A054032E01
(b) Align the timing tube knock pin with the knock pin
groove of the drive gear, and temporarily install the
drive gear with the 4 bolts.
(c) Using SST and a 5 mm hexagon wrench, uniformly
tighten the 4 bolts in several steps.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing tube.
5 mm Hexagon
Wrench
SST
A054029E02
(d) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A003173
(e) Align the camshaft knock pin with the knock pin
groove of the timing tube, and push the timing tube
by hand until it touches the bottom.
(f) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the bolt.
Torque: 78 N*m (795 kgf*cm, 58 ft.*lbf)
(g) Install the seal washer and screw plug.
Torque: 15 N*m (152 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
10 mm Hexagon
Wrench
3.
A054031E02
INSTALL CAMSHAFT (for RH Side)
NOTICE:
• As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small,
the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the
portion of the cylinder head which receives the
shaft thrust may crack or be damaged. To avoid
this, the following steps should be carried out.
• Having the crankshaft pulley at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to come
into contact with each other when installing the
camshaft. Be sure to set the crankshaft pulley at
the correct angle as shown in the illustration.
EM
EM–34
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
Crankshaft pulley
45°
Cut Part
Matchmarks
A134393E01
(a) Apply engine oil to the thrust portion of the intake
and exhaust camshafts.
(b) Align the timing marks (1-dot mark) of the camshaft
drive and driven main gears, and place the 2
camshafts.
(c) Set the timing marks (1-dot mark) of the camshaft
drive and driven main gears at approx. 10° angle.
Apporx. 10°
EM
A054974E01
(d) Apply seal packing to the camshaft housing plug.
• Remove the old packing (FIPG) material.
• Apply seal packing to the housing plug.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
Seal Packing
A054975E01
(e) Install the camshaft housing plug and oil control
valve filter to the cylinder head as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
A054976
Seal Width
1.5 to 2.0 mm
(f)
Seal Packing
Groove
A072712E01
Apply seal packing to the front bearing cap.
• Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the bearing cap and cylinder head.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and groove.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
EM–35
• Apply seal packing to the bearing cap as shown
in the illustration.
Use a nozzle that has been cut to 1.5 to 2.0 mm
(0.059 to 0.079 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
NOTICE:
Do not apply seal packing to the front bearing
cap grooves.
(g) Install the front bearing cap.
HINT:
The thrust position of the camshaft will be
determined after installing the front bearing cap.
(h) Install the other bearing caps in the order shown
with the arrow mark facing forward.
A054977
(i)
Push in the camshaft setting oil seal.
Push
A054978E01
(j)
E
D
C
E
A
B
E
D
E
C
A004469E01
Install new seal washers to the bearing cap bolts (A
and B).
(k) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts (D and E).
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil under the heads of the
bearing cap bolts (A), (B) and (C).
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
94 mm (3.70 in.) for A with seal washer
72 mm (2.83 in.) for B with seal washer
25 mm (0.98 in.) for C
55 mm (2.17 in.) for D
40 mm (1.57 in.) for E
(l) Install the oil feed pipe and the 22 bearing cap bolts
as shown in the illustration.
EM
EM–36
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
21
8
5
14
9
17
10
3
4
11
15
7
13
1
12
6
19
20
(m) Uniformly tighten the 22 bearing cap bolts in several
steps, in the order shown in the illustration.
Torque: For bolt C
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
For others
16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
2
22
16
18
A054151E04
(n) Bring the service bolt installed in the driven subgear upward by turning the hexagonal portion of the
camshaft with a wrench.
(o) Remove the service bolt.
4.
EM
Service Bolt
A054149E01
INSTALL CAMSHAFT (for LH Side)
NOTICE:
• As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small,
the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the
portion of the cylinder head which receives the
shaft thrust may crack or be damaged. To avoid
this, the following steps should be carried out.
• Having the crankshaft pulley at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to come
into contact with each other when removing the
camshaft. Always set the crankshaft pulley at the
correct angle as shown in the illustration.
(a) Apply MP grease to the thrust portions of the
camshafts.
(b) Align the timing marks (2-dot marks) of the camshaft
drive and driven main gears, and place the 2
camshafts.
A054979
(c) Apply seal packing to the camshaft housing plug.
• Remove the old packing (FIPG) material.
• Apply seal packing to the housing plug.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
Seal Packing
A054975E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
EM–37
(d) Install the camshaft housing plug and oil control
valve filter to the cylinder head as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
B002649
Seal Packing
Seal Width
1.5 to 2.0 mm
Groove
A072713E01
(e) Apply seal packing to the front bearing cap.
• Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the bearing cap and cylinder head.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and groove.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
• Apply seal packing to the bearing cap as shown
in the illustration.
Use a nozzle that has been cut to 1.5 to 2.0 mm
(0.059 to 0.079 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
NOTICE:
Do not apply seal packing to the front bearing
cap grooves.
(f)
Install the front bearing cap.
HINT:
The thrust position of the camshaft will be
determined after installing the front bearing cap.
(g) Install the other bearing cap in the order shown with
the arrow mark facing forward.
A054981
EM
EM–38
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
(h) Push in the camshaft setting oil seal.
Push
A054982E01
A
(i)
A
E
B
B
D
E
E
E
C
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
EM
D
E
E
1
Install a new seal washer to the bearing cap bolt (A
and B).
(j) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts (D and E).
(k) Install the camshafts of the LH bank.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil under the heads of the
bearing cap bolts (A), (B) and (C).
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
94 mm (3.70 in.) for A with seal washer
72 mm (2.83 in.) for B with seal washer
25 mm (0.98 in.) for C
55 mm (2.17 in.) for D
40 mm (1.57 in.) for E
(l) Install the oil feed pipe and the 22 bearing cap bolts
as shown in the illustration.
C
A054154E03
(m) Uniformly tighten the 22 bearing cap bolts in several
steps, in the order shown in the illustration.
Torque: For bolt C
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
For others
16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
21
2
10
3
4
6
14
9
5
17
7
22
12
13
11
15
19
18
8
20
16
A054154E04
(n) Bring the service bolt installed in the driven subgear upward by turning the hexagonal portion of the
camshaft with a wrench.
(o) Remove the service bolt.
5.
Service Bolt
A054152E01
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Turn the camshaft and position the cam lobe
upward, and check and adjust the valve clearance
(See page EM-8).
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
6.
Seal Packing
EM–39
INSTALL SEMICIRCULAR PLUG (for RH Side)
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the semicircular plug grooves.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
EM07143E01
(c) Install the 2 semicircular plugs to the cylinder heads.
EM
A070501E01
7.
Seal Packing
INSTALL SEMICIRCULAR PLUG (for LH Side)
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the semicircular plug grooves.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
EM07143E01
(c) Install the 4 semicircular plugs to the cylinder heads.
8.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY SUB
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Align the camshaft timing tube knock pin with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley.
(b) Attach the timing pulley to the camshaft timing tube.
Face the timing pulley's "R" mark forward.
(c) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft.
(d) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.1 N*m (83 kgf*cm, 72 ft.*lbf)
A070504E01
A134394
EM–40
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
10. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Align the camshaft timing tube knock pin with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley.
(b) Attach the timing pulley to the camshaft timing tube.
Face the timing pulley's "L" mark forward.
(c) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft.
(d) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.1 N*m (83 kgf*cm, 72 in.*lbf)
A134396
EM
A070502E01
A070505E01
11. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER (for RH Side)
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder heads as shown
in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
(c) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(d) Install the seal washer to the bolt.
(e) Install the cylinder head cover with the 18 bolts.
Uniformly tighten the bolts in several steps. Install
the 2 cylinder head covers.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
12. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER (for LH Side)
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder heads as shown
in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
(c) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(d) Install the seal washer to the bolt.
(e) Install the cylinder head cover with the 18 bolts.
Uniformly tighten the bolts in several steps. Install
the 2 cylinder head covers.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
13. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 4 bolts and ignition coil assembly.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
14. INSTALL TIMING BELT
HINT:
(See page EM-19)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
EM–5
DRIVE BELT
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
EM
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
A119828E03
EM–6
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
REMOVAL
1.
B000809
EM
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
(a) Loosen the belt tension by turning the belt tensioner
counterclockwise, and then remove the fan and
generator V belt.
HINT:
The pulley bolt for the belt tensioner has left-hand
thread.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–45
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-10)
2.
REMOVE TIMING BELT
HINT:
(See page EM-18)
3.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (for RH Side) (See page EM-28)
4.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (for LH Side)
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
5.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and transmission oil filler tube.
6.
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
(a) Remove the bolt and oil level gauge guide.
7.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-501)
8.
REMOVE WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Remove the water inlet housing and O-ring from the
engine.
9.
REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT FR
(a) Remove the 4 nuts.
(b) Remove the water by-pass joint and 2 gaskets.
10. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and water by-pass pipe.
11. REMOVE NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (See page
EC-18)
12. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
(a) Remove the 4 nuts, water by-pass joint and 2
gaskets.
13. REMOVE ENGINE WIRE
14. REMOVE NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 rear timing belt plate
RH.
15. REMOVE REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Remove the bolt, stud bolt and rear timing plate RH.
16. REMOVE NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 rear timing belt plate
LH.
17. REMOVE REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Remove the bolt and rear timing belt plate LH.
18. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the front exhaust
pipe.
EM
EM–46
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
1
7
9
6
4
3
5
10
8
2
19. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Uniformly loosen the 10 cylinder head bolts in the
order shown in the illustration. Remove the bolts
and plate washers.
NOTICE:
• Cylinder head warpage or cracking could
result from removing bolts in incorrect order.
• Do not drop the plate washer for cylinder
head bolt into portion A as shown in the
illustration. If dropped into the portion A, the
plate washer will pass through the cylinder
head and cylinder block into the oil pan.
A
EM
A139498E01
A134397
(b) Remove the cylinder head from the dowels on the
cylinder block, and place the cylinder head on
wooden blocks on a bench.
HINT:
If the cylinder head is lifted off, pry off between the
cylinder head and cylinder block with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the contact
surfaces of the cylinder head and cylinder
block.
• The cylinder head should not be tilted so as
to secure the valve lifter. If the cylinder head
is tilted, remove the valve lifter and check that
the adjusting shim is set correctly.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
2
8
10
5
3
4
6
9
7
1
EM–47
20. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Uniformly loosen the 10 cylinder head bolts in the
order shown in the illustration. Remove the bolts
and plate washers.
HINT:
• Cylinder head warpage or cracking could result
from removing bolts in incorrect order.
• Do not drop the plate washer for the cylinder
head bolt into portion A of the cylinder head. If
dropped into portion A, the plate washer will pass
through the cylinder head and cylinder block into
the oil pan.
A
EM
A139499E01
(b) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the
cylinder block, and place the cylinder head on
wooden blocks on a bench.
HINT:
If the cylinder head cannot be lifted easily, pry
between the cylinder head and cylinder block with a
screwdriver.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the contact
surfaces of the cylinder head and cylinder
block.
• The cylinder head should not be tilted so as
to secure the valve lifter. If the cylinder head
is tilted, remove the valve lifter and check that
the adjusting shim is set correctly.
A134401
21. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
22. REMOVE NO. 2 CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
INSPECTION
1.
A003194
CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and bring each piston to the top
dead center (TDC). Using a gasket scraper, remove
all the carbon from the piston top surface.
EM–48
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(b) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket
material from the cylinder block surface.
(c) Using compressed air, blow carbon and oil from the
bolt holes.
CAUTION:
Protect your eyes when using compressed air.
A134400
2.
EM
CHECK CYLINDER BLOCK FOR WARPAGE
(a) Inspect for warpage.
(1) Using a precision straight edge and feeler
gauge, measure the warpage of the contact
surfaces of the cylinder head and crankshaft
bearing cap.
Maximum warpage:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum,
replace the cylinder block sub-assembly.
Cylinder Head Side
Crankshaft Bearing Cap Side
A074955E02
(b) Visually check the cylinder for vertical scratches.
If deep scratches are present, rebore all the 8
cylinders and replace all the 8 pistons. If necessary,
replace the cylinder block.
A004853
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
3.
EM–49
CLEAN CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the cylinder head.
(1) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket
material from the cylinder block contact
surface.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
A053862
(2) Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from
the combustion chambers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
EM
A053863
(3) Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent,
clean all the guide bushes.
P021861
(4) Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly
clean the cylinder head.
EM06325
EM–50
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
4.
CHECK CYLINDER HEAD FOR WARPAGE
(a) Inspect for warpage.
(1) Using a precision straight edge and feeler
gauge, measure the warpage of the contact
surfaces of the cylinder block and the
manifolds.
Maximum warpage:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum,
replace the cylinder head.
EM
A005592
(b) Inspect for cracks.
(1) Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion
chamber, intake ports, exhaust ports and
cylinder block surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
EM06327
5.
Measuring Point
75 to 85 mm (2.95 to 3.35 in.)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thread outside
diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
9.810 to 9.960 mm (0.3862 to 0.3921 in.)
Minimum outside diameter:
9.700 mm (0.3819 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
bolt.
A002827E01
INSTALLATION
1.
A134400
INSTALL NO. 2 CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Place a new cylinder head gasket in position on the
cylinder block.
HINT:
A mark is placed on the rear side of the cylinder
head gasket to distinguish the LH and RH banks, a
"2R" mark for the RH bank and a "2L" mark for the
LH bank.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–51
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the cylinder head in position on the cylinder
head gasket.
2.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Place a new cylinder head gasket in position on the
cylinder block.
HINT:
A mark is placed on the rear side of the cylinder
head gasket to distinguish the LH and RH banks, a
"2R" mark for the RH bank and a "2L" mark for the
LH bank.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the cylinder head in position on the cylinder
head gasket.
3.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check that the timing mark of the crankshaft timing
pulley is in the position shown in the illustration, and
that the piston is below the TDC of compression.
(b) Install the cylinder head with the exhaust manifold to
the cylinder block.
HINT:
• The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps.
• If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed,
replace it.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(d) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
A134398
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
G039657E02
9
3
1
6
8
7
5
2
4
10
(e) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 cylinder head
bolts, and plate washers, in the order shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the cylinder head
bolt.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the plate washer for the cylinder
head bolt into portion A of the cylinder head. If
dropped into portion A, the plate washer will
pass through the cylinder head and cylinder
block into the oil pan.
A
A139500E01
EM
EM–52
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(f)
Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head with
paint.
(g) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90° in the order
shown.
(h) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by an additional
90°.
(i) Check that the painted mark is now at a 180° angle
to front.
90°
180°
Painted Mark
A011159E01
4.
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
EM
G039657E02
10
4
2
5
7
8
6
1
3
9
A
A139501E01
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the timing mark of the crankshaft timing
pulley is in the position shown in the illustration, and
that the piston is below the TDC of compression.
(b) Install the cylinder head with the exhaust manifold to
the cylinder block.
HINT:
• The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps.
• If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed,
replace it.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(d) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
(e) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 cylinder head
bolts, and plate washers, in the order shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the cylinder head
bolt.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the plate washer for the cylinder
head bolt into portion A of the cylinder head. If
dropped into portion A, the plate washer will
pass through the cylinder head and cylinder
block into the oil pan.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–53
(f)
Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head with
paint.
(g) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90° in the order
shown.
(h) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by an additional
90°.
(i) Check that the painted mark is now at a 180° angle
to front.
90°
180°
Painted Mark
5.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Place a new gasket to the front exhaust pipe.
(b) Install the 2 nuts and front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 62 N*m (632 kgf*cm, 46 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Install the bolt and rear timing belt plate LH.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Install the 2 bolts and No. 2 rear timing belt plate LH.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
A011159E01
8.
INSTALL REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Install the timing belt plate with the bolt and stud
bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Install the timing belt plate with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
10. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR (See page EM88)
11. INSTALL NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (See page
EC-19)
12. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT FR (See page EM88)
13. INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING (See page CO-10)
14. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the water by-pass pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
(c) Push in the water by-pass pipe end into the pipe
hole of the water pump.
(d) Install the water by-pass pipe with the bolt.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
15. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-503)
16. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
(a) Install a new O-ring to the oil level gauge guide.
(b) Install the oil level gauge guide with the bolt.
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
EM
EM–54
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
17. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the transmission oil filler tube sub-assembly
with the bolt.
Torque: 12 N*m (122 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
18. INSTALL CAMSHAFT (for LH Side) (See page EM-36)
19. INSTALL CAMSHAFT (for RH Side) (See page EM-33)
20. INSTALL TIMING BELT
HINT:
(See page EM-19)
EM
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–7
VALVE CLEARANCE
ADJUSTMENT
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
SEPARATE BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
3.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
6.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
7.
REMOVE OIL COOLER PIPE (See page EM-85)
8.
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page EM-85)
10. REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
(See page EM-85)
11. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 9 bolts, 9 seal washers and cylinder
head cover.
12. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the PCV hose.
(b) Remove the 9 bolts, 9 seal washers and cylinder
head cover.
13. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley to align its notch with
timing mark "0" of the No. 1 timing belt cover.
A003330
(b) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys and timing belt rear plates are aligned.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°) and align the marks as above.
A134357
EM
EM–8
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
14. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Check only the valves indicated.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
(2) Record the out-of-specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to
determine the required replacement adjusting
shim.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake:
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust:
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
RH Cylinder Head
EX
IN
LH Cylinder Head
Front
IN
EM
EX
A005717E03
(b) Turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution (360°)
and align the camshaft timing marks.
(c) Check only the valves indicated as shown in the
illustration. Measure the valve clearance.
RH Cylinder Head
EX
15. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Remove the timing belt (See page EM-18).
(b) Remove the camshafts (RH Bank) (See page EM28).
(c) Remove the camshafts (LH Bank) (See page EM29).
(d) Remove the valve lifter and adjusting shim.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the adjusting shim into
the cylinder head.
IN
Front
LH Cylinder Head
IN
EX
A004457E03
A002213
(e) Determine the replacement adjusting shim size
according to the formula or charts on the following
pages.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of
the removed shim.
(2) Calculate the thickness of a new shim so that
the valve clearance comes within the specified
value.
T:
Thickness of removed shim
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–9
A:
Measured valve clearance
N:
Thickness of new shim
Intake:
N = T + (A - 0.20 mm (0.008 in.))
Exhaust:
N = T + (A - 0.30 mm (0.012 in.))
(3) Select a new shim with a thickness as close as
possible to the calculated value.
HINT:
• Shims are available in 41 increments of
0.020 mm (0.0008 in.), from 2.00 mm
(0.0787 in.) to 2.80 mm (0.1102 in.).
• Refer to the new adjusting shim thickness
table on the next 2 pages.
EM
EM–10
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
Valve Lifter Selection Chart (Intake)
0.000 - 0.030 (0.0000 - 0.0012)
0.031 - 0.050 (0.0012 - 0.0020)
0.051 - 0.070 (0.0020 - 0.0028)
0.071 - 0.090 (0.0028 - 0.0035)
0.091 - 0.110 (0.0036 - 0.0043)
0.111 - 0.130 (0.0044 - 0.0051)
0.131 - 0.149 (0.0052 - 0.0059)
0.150 - 0.250 (0.0059 - 0.0098)
0.251 - 0.270 (0.0099 - 0.0106)
0.271 - 0.290 (0.0107 - 0.0114)
0.291 - 0.310 (0.0115 - 0.0122)
0.311 - 0.330 (0.0122 - 0.0130)
0.331 - 0.350 (0.0130 - 0.0138)
0.351 - 0.370 (0.0138 - 0.0146)
0.371 - 0.390 (0.0146 - 0.0154)
0.391 - 0.410 (0.0154 - 0.0161)
0.411 - 0.430 (0.0162 - 0.0169)
0.431 - 0.450 (0.0170 - 0.0177)
0.451 - 0.470 (0.0178 - 0.0185)
0.471 - 0.490 (0.0185 - 0.0193)
0.491 - 0.510 (0.0193 - 0.0201)
0.511 - 0.530 (0.0201 - 0.0209)
0.531 - 0.550 (0.0209 - 0.0217)
0.551 - 0.570 (0.0217 - 0.0224)
0.571 - 0.590 (0.0225 - 0.0232)
0.591 - 0.610 (0.0233 - 0.0240)
0.611 - 0.630 (0.0241 - 0.0248)
0.631 - 0.650 (0.0248 - 0.0256)
0.651 - 0.670 (0.0256 - 0.0264)
0.671 - 0.690 (0.0264 - 0.0272)
0.691 - 0.710 (0.0272 - 0.0280)
0.711 - 0.730 (0.0280 - 0.0287)
0.731 - 0.750 (0.0288 - 0.0295)
0.751 - 0.770 (0.0296 - 0.0303)
0.771 - 0.790 (0.0304 - 0.0311)
0.791 - 0.810 (0.0311 - 0.0319)
0.811 - 0.830 (0.0319 - 0.0327)
0.831 - 0.850 (0.0327 - 0.0335)
0.851 - 0.870 (0.0335 - 0.0343)
0.871 - 0.890 (0.0343 - 0.0350)
0.891 - 0.910 (0.0351 - 0.0358)
0.911 - 0.930 (0.0359 - 0.0366)
0.931 - 0.950 (0.0367 - 0.0374)
0.951 - 0.970 (0.0374 - 0.0382)
0.971 - 0.990 (0.0382 - 0.0390)
0.991 - 1.010 (0.0390 - 0.0398)
1.011 - 1.030 (0.0398 - 0.0406)
1.031 - 1.050 (0.0406 - 0.0413)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16
EM
Removed
lifter
thickness
mm (in.)
2.000 (0.0787)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08
Measured
clearance
mm (in.)
00 00
2.020 (0.0795)
00 00 00
2.040 (0.0803)
00 00 00 00
2.060 (0.0811)
02 00 00 00 00
2.080 (0.0819)
04 02 00 00 00 00
2.100 (0.0827)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18
06 04 02 00 00 00 00 2.120 (0.0835)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20
08 06 04 02 00 00 00 2.140 (0.0843)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22
10 08 06 04 02 00 00 2.160 (0.0850)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24
12 10 08 06 04 02 00 2.180 (0.0858)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26
14 12 10 08 06 04 02 2.200 (0.0866)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28
16 14 12 10 08 06 02 2.210 (0.0870)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28
16 14 12 10 08 06 04 2.220 (0.0874)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30
18 16 14 12 10 08 04 2.230 (0.0878)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30
18 16 14 12 10 08 06 2.240 (0.0882)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32
20 18 16 14 12 10 06 2.250 (0.0886)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32
20 18 16 14 12 10 08 2.260 (0.0890)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34
22 20 18 16 14 12 08 2.270 (0.0894)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 2.280 (0.0898)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36
24 22 20 18 16 14 10 2.290 (0.0902)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36
24 22 20 18 16 14 12 2.300 (0.0906)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38
26 24 22 20 18 16 12 2.310 (0.0909)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38
26 24 22 20 18 16 14 2.320 (0.0913)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40
28 26 24 22 20 18 14 2.330 (0.0917)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40
28 26 24 22 20 18 16 2.340 (0.0921)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42
30 28 26 24 22 20 16 2.350 (0.0925)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42
30 28 26 24 22 20 18 2.360 (0.0929)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44
32 30 28 26 24 22 18 2.370 (0.0933)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44
32 30 28 26 24 22 20 2.380 (0.0937)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46
34 32 30 28 26 24 20 2.390 (0.0941)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46
34 32 30 28 26 24 22 2.400 (0.0945)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48
36 34 32 30 28 26 22 2.410 (0.0949)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48
36 34 32 30 28 26 24 2.420 (0.0953)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50
38 36 34 32 30 28 24 2.430 (0.0957)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50
38 36 34 32 30 28 26 2.440 (0.0961)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52
40 38 36 34 32 30 26 2.450 (0.0965)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52
40 38 36 34 32 30 28 2.460 (0.0969)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54
42 40 38 36 34 32 28 2.470 (0.0972)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54
42 40 38 36 34 32 30 2.480 (0.0976)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56
44 42 40 38 36 34 30 2.490 (0.0980)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56
44 42 40 38 36 34 32 2.500 (0.0984)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58
46 44 42 40 38 36 32 2.510 (0.0988)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58
46 44 42 40 38 36 34 2.520 (0.0992)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60
48 46 44 42 40 38 34 2.530 (0.0996)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60
48 46 44 42 40 38 36 2.540 (0.1000)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62
50 48 46 44 42 40 36 2.550 (0.1004)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62
50 48 46 44 42 40 38 2.560 (0.1008)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64
52 50 48 46 44 42 38 2.570 (0.1012)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64
52 50 48 46 44 42 40 2.580 (0.1016)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66
54 52 50 48 46 44 40 2.590 (0.1020)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66
54 52 50 48 46 44 42 2.600 (0.1024)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68
56 54 52 50 48 46 44 2.620 (0.1031)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70
58 56 54 52 50 48 46 2.640 (0.1039)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72
60 58 56 54 52 50 48 2.660 (0.1047)
80 80 80 78 76 74
62 60 58 56 54 52 50 2.680 (0.1055)
80 80 80 78 76
64 62 60 58 56 54 52 2.700 (0.1063)
80 80 80 78
66 64 62 60 58 56 54 2.720 (0.1071)
80 80 80
68 66 64 62 60 58 56 2.740 (0.1079)
80 80
70 68 66 64 62 60 58 2.760 (0.1087)
80
72 70 68 66 64 62 60 2.780 (0.1094)
74 72 70 68 66 64 62 2.800 (0.1102)
A134420
EM–11
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
Valve Lifter Selection Chart (Exhaust)
0.000 - 0.030 (0.0000 - 0.0012)
0.031 - 0.050 (0.0012 - 0.0020)
0.051 - 0.070 (0.0020 - 0.0028)
0.071 - 0.090 (0.0028 - 0.0035)
0.091 - 0.110 (0.0036 - 0.0043)
0.111 - 0.130 (0.0044 - 0.0051)
0.131 - 0.150 (0.0052 - 0.0059)
0.151 - 0.170 (0.0059 - 0.0067)
0.171 - 0.190 (0.0067 - 0.0075)
0.191 - 0.210 (0.0075 - 0.0083)
0.211 - 0.230 (0.0083 - 0.0091)
0.231 - 0.249 (0.0091 - 0.0098)
0.250 - 0.350 (0.0098 - 0.0138)
0.351 - 0.370 (0.0138 - 0.0146)
0.371 - 0.390 (0.0146 - 0.0154)
0.391 - 0.410 (0.0154 - 0.0161)
0.411 - 0.430 (0.0162 - 0.0169)
0.431 - 0.450 (0.0170 - 0.0177)
0.451 - 0.470 (0.0178 - 0.0185)
0.471 - 0.490 (0.0185 - 0.0193)
0.491 - 0.510 (0.0193 - 0.0201)
0.511 - 0.530 (0.0201 - 0.0209)
0.531 - 0.550 (0.0209 - 0.0217)
0.551 - 0.570 (0.0217 - 0.0224)
0.571 - 0.590 (0.0225 - 0.0232)
0.591 - 0.610 (0.0233 - 0.0240)
0.611 - 0.630 (0.0241 - 0.0248)
0.631 - 0.650 (0.0248 - 0.0256)
0.651 - 0.670 (0.0256 - 0.0264)
0.671 - 0.690 (0.0264 - 0.0272)
0.691 - 0.710 (0.0272 - 0.0280)
0.711 - 0.730 (0.0280 - 0.0287)
0.731 - 0.750 (0.0288 - 0.0295)
0.751 - 0.770 (0.0296 - 0.0303)
0.771 - 0.790 (0.0304 - 0.0311)
0.791 - 0.810 (0.0311 - 0.0319)
0.811 - 0.830 (0.0319 - 0.0327)
0.831 - 0.850 (0.0327 - 0.0335)
0.851 - 0.870 (0.0335 - 0.0343)
0.871 - 0.890 (0.0343 - 0.0350)
0.891 - 0.910 (0.0351 - 0.0358)
0.911 - 0.930 (0.0359 - 0.0366)
0.931 - 0.950 (0.0367 - 0.0374)
0.951 - 0.970 (0.0374 - 0.0382)
0.971 - 0.990 (0.0382 - 0.0390)
0.991 - 1.010 (0.0390 - 0.0398)
1.011 - 1.030 (0.0398 - 0.0406)
1.031 - 1.050 (0.0406 - 0.0413)
1.051 - 1.070 (0.0414 - 0.0421)
1.071 - 1.090 (0.0422 - 0.0429)
1.091 - 1.110 (0.0430 - 0.0437)
1.111 - 1.130 (0.0437 - 0.0445)
1.131 - 1.150 (0.0445 - 0.0453)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08
Measured
clearance
mm (in.)
Removed
lifter
thickness
mm (in.)
2.000 (0.0787)
00 00
2.020 (0.0795)
00 00 00
2.040 (0.0803)
00 00 00 00
2.060 (0.0811)
02 00 00 00 00
2.080 (0.0819)
04 02 00 00 00 00
2.100 (0.0827)
06 04 02 00 00 00 00
2.120 (0.0835)
08 06 04 02 00 00 00 00
2.140 (0.0843)
10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 00
2.160 (0.0850)
12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 00
2.180 (0.0858)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26
14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 00
2.200 (0.0866)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28
16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 00 2.210 (0.0870)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28
16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 00 2.220 (0.0874)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30
18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 2.230 (0.0878)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30
18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 00 2.240 (0.0882)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32
20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 2.250 (0.0886)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32
20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 00 2.260 (0.0890)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 2.270 (0.0894)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 00 2.280 (0.0898)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36
24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 00 2.290 (0.0902)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36
24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 02 2.300 (0.0906)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38
26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 02 2.310 (0.0909)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38
26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 04 2.320 (0.0913)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40
28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 04 2.330 (0.0917)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40
28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 06 2.340 (0.0921)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42
30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 06 2.350 (0.0925)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42
30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 08 2.360 (0.0929)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44
32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 08 2.370 (0.0933)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44
32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 10 2.380 (0.0937)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46
34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 10 2.390 (0.0941)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46
34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 12 2.400 (0.0945)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48
36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 12 2.410 (0.0949)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48
36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 14 2.420 (0.0953)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50
38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 14 2.430 (0.0957)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50
38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 16 2.440 (0.0961)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52
40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 16 2.450 (0.0965)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52
40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 18 2.460 (0.0969)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54
42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 18 2.470 (0.0972)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54
42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 20 2.480 (0.0976)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56
44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 20 2.490 (0.0980)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56
44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 22 2.500 (0.0984)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58
46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 22 2.510 (0.0988)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58
46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 24 2.520 (0.0992)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60
48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 24 2.530 (0.0996)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60
48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 26 2.540 (0.1000)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62
50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 26 2.550 (0.1004)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64 62
50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 28 2.560 (0.1008)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64
52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 28 2.570 (0.1012)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66 64
52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 30 2.580 (0.1016)
80 80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66
54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 30 2.590 (0.1020)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68 66
54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 32 2.600 (0.1024)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70 68
56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 2.620 (0.1031)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72 70
58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 2.640 (0.1039)
80 80 80 78 76 74 72
60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 38 2.660 (0.1047)
80 80 80 78 76 74
62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 40 2.680 (0.1055)
80 80 80 78 76
64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 42 2.700 (0.1063)
80 80 80 78
66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 44 2.720 (0.1071)
80 80 80
68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 46 2.740 (0.1079)
80 80
70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 48 2.760 (0.1087)
80
72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 50 2.780 (0.1094)
74 72 70 68 66 64 62 60 58 56 54 52 2.800 (0.1102)
EM
A134421
EM–12
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
(f) Place a new adjusting shim on the valve.
(g) Place the valve lifter.
(h) Reinstall the camshafts (LH Bank) (See page EM36).
(i) Reinstall the camshafts (RH Bank) (See page EM33).
(j) Reinstall the timing belt (See page EM-19).
(k) Recheck the valve clearance.
16. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
17. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
18. INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER (See
page EM-90)
19. INSTALL NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page EM-90)
EM
20. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
21. INSTALL OIL COOLER PIPE (See page EM-90)
22. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
23. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
24. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
25. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
26. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
27. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL
EM–59
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TIMING BELT
HINT:
(See page EM-18)
2.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Using SST, remove the timing pulley.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05010)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the timing pulley.
3.
REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
SST
A004445E01
Cut Position
A004863E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL OIL PUMP SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011)
2.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Align the timing pulley set key with the key groove of
the pulley.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the timing pulley
with the flange side facing inward.
SST 09223-46011
3.
INSTALL TIMING BELT
HINT:
(See page EM-19)
SST
A004864E02
Inward
SST
A004446E01
EM
EM–13
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
TIMING BELT
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR SUPPORT
SEAL UPPER
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
EM
FAN SHROUD
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
29 (296, 11)
FAN PULLEY
FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
29 (296, 11)
ENGINE UNDER COVER
ASSEMBLY REAR
NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)
29 (296, 11)
A119828E02
EM–14
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
16 (160, 12)
NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN
OR BELT COVER
EM
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
32 (330, 24)
NO. 2 TIMING BELT
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
COVER PLATE
26 (270, 19)
39 (400, 29)
NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
OIL COOLER PIPE
47 (475, 34)
COMPRESSOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
25 (255, 18)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119829E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING BELT
EM–15
V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
9.8 (100, 86 in.*lbf)
16 (160, 12)
TIMING BELT NO. 1 COVER
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
39 (400, 29)
245 (2,500, 181 )
EM
39 (400, 29)
16 (160, 12)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
TIMING BELT
NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119830E01
EM–66
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
REMOVAL
EM
1.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 2WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-348)
2.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 4WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-361)
3.
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-70011, 09330-00021
SST
A134399E01
(b) Remove the 8 bolts, front spacer, drive plate and
rear spacer.
A004857
4.
Cut Position
REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
A004858E01
INSTALLATION
SST
1.
A004859E01
INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-56010
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
2.
EM–67
INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-70011, 09330-00021
SST
A134399E01
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the mounting
bolt end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or equivalent
Adhesive
EM
A004869E03
1
(c) Install the front spacer, drive plate and rear spacer
on the crankshaft.
(d) Install and uniformly tighten the 8 mounting bolts in
several steps, in the order shown in the illustration.
Torque: 30 N*m (301 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
If any one of the mounting bolts does not meet the
torque specification, replace the mounting bolt.
5
8
3
4
7
6
2
A004857E01
(e) Mark the mounting bolt with paint (Procedure "A").
(f) Retighten the mounting bolts by 90° in the order
shown.
(g) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to
the mark placed in procedure "A".
Painted Mark
90°
90°
3.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 4WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-362)
4.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 2WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-349)
A087896E01
EM–25
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
CAMSHAFT
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RH BANK:
6.0 (60, 53 in.*lbf)
x9
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
OIL FEED PIPE
GASKET
16 (160, 12)
CAMSHAFT SETTING
OIL SEAL
16 (160, 12)
EM
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
BEARING CAP
CAMSHAFT
DRIVE GEAR
BEARING CAP
CAMSHAFT TIMING TUBE ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 CAMSHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
78 (795, 58)
SEAL WASHER
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
CAMSHAFT GEAR SPRING
15 (152, 11)
SCREW PLUG
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
8.1 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT TIMING
PULLEY RH
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR WAVE WASHER
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR SHAFT SNAP RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119831E01
EM–26
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CAMSHAFT
LH BANK:
x9
6.0 (60, 53 in.*lbf)
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
OIL FEED PIPE
GASKET
16 (160, 12)
BEARING CAP
CAMSHAFT TIMING
TUBE ASSEMBLY
EM
16 (160, 12)
CAMSHAFT
SETTING OIL
SEAL
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT
DRIVE GEAR
78 (795, 58)
CAMSHAFT
BEARING
CAP
SEAL WASHER
15 (152, 11)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
SCREW PLUG
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
8.1 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT GEAR SPRING
CAMSHAFT
TIMING
PULLEY LH
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR WAVE WASHER
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR SHAFT SNAP RING
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119832E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–81
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-10)
2.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 2WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-348)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 4WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-361)
4.
REMOVE HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the windshield washer hose.
(b) Disconnect the hood dampers.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and hood sub-assembly.
5.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and throttle body cover subassembly.
6.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hoses (for P/S idle up and
for fuel pressure regulator) and ventilation hose.
7.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the intake air flow meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the ground cable from the body.
(c) Remove the air cleaner cap and air cleaner
element.
(d) Remove the 3 bolts and air cleaner assembly.
8.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
10. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
11. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the engine
oil.
(b) Clean the oil pan drain plug and install a new gasket
and the drain plug.
Torque: 39 N*m (398 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
12. REMOVE RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page CO-14)
13. REMOVE FAN SHROUD
(a) Disconnect the fasteners of the clamp and oil cooler
hoses from the fan shroud in sequence.
(b) Remove the fan shroud with fan.
EM
EM–82
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
14. DISCONNECT NO. 2 FUEL HOSE
(a) Observe the following precautions when
disconnecting the fuel tube connector:
(1) Remove the No. 2 fuel pipe clamp.
(2) Check if there is any dirt on the pipe and
around the connector before disconnecting
them. Clean the dirt away if necessary.
No. 2 Fuel
Pipe Clamp
A060083E22
(3) Disconnect the connector from the hose while
pinching part A with fingers as shown in the
illustration.
A
A
EM
A134358E01
(4) When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
pinch the fuel pipe with fingers and push the
fuel tube connector to the fuel pipe by pressing
the release buttons, then pull the connector out
from the pipe. Do not use any tool at this time.
(5) Check if there is any dirt or other foreign
objects on the seal surface of the disconnected
pipe and clean it away.
B012944
(6) Do not damage the disconnected pipe and
connector, and prevent intrusion of foreign
objects by covering them with a plastic bag.
Plastic Bag
A134359E01
15. DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE
(a) Observe the following precautions when
disconnecting the fuel tube connector:
(1) Remove the No. 1 fuel pipe clamp.
(2) Check if there is any dirt on the pipe and
around the connector before disconnecting
them. Clean the dirt away if necessary.
No. 1 Fuel
Pipe Clamp
A060083E23
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–83
(3) Disconnect the connector from the hose while
pinching part A with fingers as shown in the
illustration.
A
A
A134358E01
(4) When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
pinch the fuel pipe with fingers and push the
fuel tube connector to the fuel pipe by pressing
the release buttons, then pull the connector out
from the pipe. Do not use any tool at this time.
(5) Check if there is any dirt or other foreign
objects on the seal surface of the disconnected
pipe and clean it away.
B012944
(6) Do not damage the disconnected pipe and
connector, and prevent intrusion of foreign
objects by covering them with a plastic bag.
Plastic Bag
16. DISCONNECT FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE ASSEMBLY
17. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
A134359E01
18. SEPARATE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose.
(b) Remove the nut, 2 bolts and vane pump assembly.
HINT:
Hang up the hose instead of detaching.
A134361
19. SEPARATE COMPRESSOR
(a) Disconnect the compressor connector.
(b) Remove the nut, 3 bolts, compressor stay and
compressor.
HINT:
Hang up the hoses instead of detaching.
A134362
EM
EM–84
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
20. REMOVE FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and fan with fluid coupling.
(b) Remove the fan pulley.
21. REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and transmission oil filler tube.
A134363
22. REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Remove the bolt and oil level gauge guide.
(b) Remove the O-ring.
23. DISCONNECT HEATER HOSE
24. SEPARATE ENGINE WIRE
(a) Remove the front door scuff plate RH (See page IP6).
(b) Remove the cowl side trim board RH (See page IP9).
(c) Remove the glove compartment door (See page IP9).
EM
(d) Disconnect each connector for the ECM, fourwheel- drive-control ECU (4WD only) and
instrument panel wire before pulling out the engine
wire into the engine room.
(e) Disconnect the 3 ground cables from the body.
(f) Disconnect the No. 2 engine wire from the battery
terminals (positive and negative) and engine room
relay block.
A070478
25. REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts and 4 bolts.
(c) Lift the engine out of the vehicle slowly and
carefully.
HINT:
Make sure that the engine is kept clear of all wiring
hoses and cables.
26. REMOVE ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the VSV connector.
(b) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
A070480
27. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-501)
28. REMOVE NO. 2 WIRING HARNESS HEAT
INSULATOR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 wiring harness heat
insulator.
29. REMOVE NO. 2 ENGINE WIRE
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the ground cable
wire.
(b) Remove the nut, 2 bolts and No. 2 engine wire.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–85
30. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
FRONT RH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the engine-mounting
bracket together with the engine-mounting insulator
front.
31. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
FRONT LH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the engine-mounting
bracket together with the engine-mounting insulator
front.
32. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CH-10)
33. REMOVE HEATER HOSE
34. REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUBASSEMBLY (See page EM-66)
35. REMOVE OIL COOLER PIPE
(a) Disconnect the 3 hoses.
(b) Remove the bolt, nut and oil cooler pipe.
36. REMOVE PUMP BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and pump bracket.
37. REMOVE NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the grommet and separate the cam
position sensor connector from the No. 3 timing belt
cover sub-assembly LH.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 3 timing belt cover subassembly LH.
A014424
38. REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
(a) Remove the nut, 3 bolts and No. 2 timing belt cover.
A134364
39. REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 timing belt cover subassembly.
A054467
EM
EM–86
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
40. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and V-ribbed belt tensioner.
A072692
41. REMOVE FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, 2 bolts and fan bracket subassembly.
42. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 8 bolts and 8 ignition coils.
43. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt, stud bolt and camshaft position
sensor.
EM
A134365
44. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and crankshaft position sensor.
45. REMOVE VVT SENSOR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and VVT sensors.
46. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the wire clamp.
(b) Remove the bolt and water by-pass.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the water by-pass pipe
sub-assembly.
47. REMOVE NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (See page
EC-18)
A134366
48. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and water by-pass joint.
(b) Remove the 2 gaskets from the water by-pass joint.
49. REMOVE AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
(See page EC-11)
50. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the No. 2 engine wire.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and starter assembly.
A134367
51. REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR (See page ES-502)
52. REMOVE WATER INLET HOUSING (See page EM-45)
EM–41
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
CYLINDER HEAD
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ENGINE WIRE
ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR
18 (185, 13)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
EM
VSV FOR AIR
INJECTION SYSTEM
WATER BY-PASS
JOINT RR
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
18 (185, 13)
GASKET
NO. 7 WATER
BY-PASS HOSE
NO. 2 FUEL HOSE
INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 FUEL PIPE CLAMP
FUEL HOSE
WATER BY-PASS PIPE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL PIPE CLAMP
18 (185, 13)
GASKET
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
O-RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119835E01
EM–42
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
NO. 2 AIR TUBE
10 (102, 7)
10 (102, 7)
GASKET
O-RING
18 (185, 13)
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
NO. 3 AIR
TUBE
18 (185, 13)
EM
GASKET
10 (102, 7)
WATER BY-PASS JOINT FR
WATER INLET HOUSING
GASKET
NO. 2 REAR TIMING
BELT PLATE RH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
IGNITION COIL
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A130723E01
EM–43
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
6.0 (60, 53 in.*lbf)
x9
CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
16 (160, 12)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
O-RING
16 (160, 12)
BEARING CAP
EM
CAMSHAFT (WITH TIMING TUBE)
BEARING CAP
*1
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT (WITH SUB GEAR)
1st: 40 (408, 30)
2nd: Turn 90°
3rd: Turn 90°
x10
SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
OIL CONTROL VALVE
FILTER
CAMSHAFT HOUSING
PLUG
ENGINE HANGER
16 (160, 12)
CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
*1: See paragraph INSTALLATION
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119834E01
EM–44
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
6.0 (60, 53 in.*lbf)
x9
GASKET
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
16 (160, 12)
CAMSHAFT TIMING
OIL CONTROL VALVE
EM
16 (160, 12)
BEARING CAP
O-RING
NO. 4 CAMSHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(WITH SUB GEAR)
BEARING CAP
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(WITH TIMING TUBE)
x10
CAMSHAFT HOUSING PLUG
*1
1st: 40 (408, 30)
2nd: Turn 90°
OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
3rd: Turn 90°
ENGINE HANGER
SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
37 (380, 27)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
*1: See paragraph INSTALLATION
A119837E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–87
53. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT FR
(a) Remove the 4 nuts, water by-pass joint and 2
gaskets.
54. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 exhaust manifold
heat insulator.
(b) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(c) Remove the 8 nuts and exhaust manifold subassembly.
A134368
55. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 2 exhaust manifold
heat insulator.
(b) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(c) Remove the 8 nuts and exhaust manifold subassembly.
56. REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and nut.
(b) Remove the oil cooler assembly with bracket and
gasket.
57. REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the ventilation valve cover.
(b) Remove the ventilation valve sub-assembly.
58. REPLACE PARTIAL ENGINE ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
B016488
(b) Install the ventilation valve.
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
After tightening the valve to the specified torque,
turn the ventilation valve clockwise with the port
facing in the direction indicated in the illustration.
(c) Install the ventilation valve cover to the ventilation
valve.
(d) Connect the ventilation hose to the ventilation valve.
15 to 25°
A072725E01
2.
INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a new gasket into the groove of the oil cooler.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the gasket.
(c) Install the oil cooler assembly with the 2 bolts and
nut.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
EM
EM–88
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Place a new gasket on the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Install the exhaust manifold with 8 new nuts.
Uniformly tighten the nuts in diagonally.
Torque: 44 N*m (450 kgf*cm, 33 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the heat insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Place a new gasket on the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Install the exhaust manifold with 8 new nuts.
Uniformly tighten the nuts diagonally.
Torque: 44 N*m (450 kgf*cm, 33 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the heat insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT FR
(a) With the flat-bottom of each new gasket facing
downward as shown in the illustration, install the 2
gaskets to the engine front side.
(b) Install the water by-pass joint with the 4 nuts.
Alternately tighten the nuts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING (See page CO-10)
7.
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR (See page ES-502)
8.
INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the starter assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the No. 2 engine wire.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 7.2 ft.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
(See page EC-12)
A134369
EM
A134370
Flat Area
A070482E01
10. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
(a) With the flat-bottom of each new gasket facing
downward as shown in the illustration, install the 2
gaskets to the engine rear side.
(b) Install the water by-pass joint with the 4 nuts.
Alternately tighten the nuts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
Flat Area
11. INSTALL NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE (See page
EC-19)
A070482E01
12. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the water by-pass pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–89
(c) Push in the water by-pass pipe end into the pipe
hole of the water pump.
(d) Install the water by-pass pipe with the bolt.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
13. INSTALL VVT SENSOR
(a) Install the VVT sensors with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
A134371
14. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install the crankshaft position sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 6.5 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 58 in.*lbf)
15. INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install the camshaft position sensor with the bolt and
the stud bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
16. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 8 ignition coils with the 8 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
17. INSTALL FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the fan bracket with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 12 mm head
16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
14 mm head
32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
A134365
18. INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the v-ribbed belt tensioner with the bolt and 2
nuts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
A072692
19. INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 2 timing belt cover sub-assembly with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
A054467
EM
EM–90
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
20. INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
(a) Install the timing chain or belt cover with the nut and
3 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
A134372
21. INSTALL NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the timing belt cover sub-assembly with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the camshaft position sensor connector and
grommet to the timing belt cover.
EM
A014424
22. INSTALL PUMP BRACKET
(a) Install the pump bracket with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
23. INSTALL OIL COOLER PIPE
(a) Install the oil cooler pipe with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 3 hoses.
24. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUBASSEMBLY (See page EM-67)
25. INSTALL HEATER HOSE
26. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CH-17)
27. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
FRONT LH
(a) Install the engine-mounting bracket and enginemounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 36 N*m (367 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
28. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
FRONT RH
(a) Install the engine-mounting bracket and enginemounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 36 N*m (367 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
29. INSTALL NO. 2 ENGINE WIRE
(a) Install the engine wire protector with the nut and 2
bolts.
(b) Connect the ground cable wire clamp with the bolt.
30. INSTALL NO. 2 WIRING HARNESS HEAT INSULATOR
(a) Install the wiring harness heat insulator with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 17 N*m (175 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
31. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-503)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–91
32. INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
33. INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
(b) Slowly lower the engine assembly into the engine
compartment.
(c) Attach the engine mounting brackets to the frame
brackets.
(d) Install the engine mounting brackets with the 4 nuts
and 4 bolts.
Torque: 38 N*m (387 kgf*cm, 28 ft.*lbf)
(e) Remove the engine chain hoist.
34. INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
35. CONNECT HEATER HOSE
36. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Install a new O-ring to the oil level gauge guide.
(b) Install the oil level gauge guide with the bolt.
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
37. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the oil filler tube subassembly.
(b) Install the transmission oil filler tube sub-assembly
with the bolt.
Torque: 12 N*m (122 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
38. INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Install the fan pulley to the engine.
(b) Install the fan with fluid coupling with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
A134363
39. INSTALL COMPRESSOR
(a) Install the compressor with the stay, nut and 3 bolts.
Torque: Bolt
47 N*m (475 kgf*cm, 34 ft.*lbf)
Nut
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the compressor connector.
A134362
EM
EM–92
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
40. INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the vane pump assembly with the nut and 2
bolts.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
41. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
42. CONNECT FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE ASSEMBLY
43. CONNECT FUEL HOSE
A134361
44. CONNECT NO. 2 FUEL HOSE
45. INSTALL FAN SHROUD
(a) Install the fan shroud with the fan into the engine
room.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
46. INSTALL RADIATOR ASSEMBLY (See page CO-14)
EM
47. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
48. ADD ENGINE OIL
49. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
50. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
51. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner assembly with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 12 N*m (122 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the wire harness clamp and the ground
cable.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
52. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
53. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the throttle body cover sub-assembly with the
2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
54. INSTALL HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hood with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the hood damper.
Torque: 18 N*m (180 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
(c) Connect the windshield washer hose.
55. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 2WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-349)
56. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
(for 4WD)
HINT:
(See page AT-362)
57. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE (See
page CO-4)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–93
58. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
59. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK (See page FU-5)
60. INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
HINT:
(See page AT-304)
61. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKAGE
EM
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL
EM–55
ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR SUPPORT
SEAL UPPER
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
EM
FAN SHROUD
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
29 (296, 21)
FAN PULLEY
FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
29 (296, 21)
ENGINE UNDER COVER
ASSEMBLY REAR
NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
29 (296, 21)
A119828E04
EM–56
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL
VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
16 (160, 12)
NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN
OR BELT COVER
EM
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
32 (330, 24)
NO. 2 TIMING BELT
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
COVER PLATE
NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
ASSEMBLY
26 (270, 19)
39 (400, 29)
NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
OIL COOLER PIPE
47 (475, 34)
COMPRESSOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
25 (255, 18)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119829E03
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL
EM–57
V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
9.8 (100, 86 in.*lbf)
16 (160, 12)
TIMING BELT NO. 1 COVER
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
39 (400, 29)
245 (2,500, 181 )
EM
39 (400, 29)
16 (158, 11)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
TIMING BELT
NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119830E02
EM–58
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL
EM
OIL PUMP SEAL
CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Non-reusable part
A119825E01
EM–60
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
2WD:
NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET TUBE
NO. 1 OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE
5 (50, 43 in.*lbf)
34 (346, 25)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
ASSEMBLY
71 (720, 53)
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CABLE
71 (720, 53)
71 (720, 53)
EM
37 (380, 35)
x6
12 (122, 9)
48 (490, 35)
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
12 (122, 9)
71 (720, 53)
37 (380, 35)
FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER
18 (184, 13)
NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR REAR
65 (663, 48)
72 (734, 53)
65 (663, 48)
NO. 3 FRAME CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET
72 (734, 53)
18 (184, 13)
33 (336, 24)
33 (336, 24)
33 (336, 24)
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET LH
33 (336, 24)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119722E04
EM–61
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
48 (490, 35)
GASKET
48 (490, 35)
EXHAUST PIPE
GASKET
62 (630, 46)
62 (630, 46)
GASKET
EM
88 (900, 65)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
88 (900, 65)
29 (296, 21)
29 (296, 21)
29 (296, 21)
ENGINE UNDER COVER
REAR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119723E02
EM–62
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
4WD:
TRANSMISSION
OIL FILLER TUBE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
ATF LEVEL GAUGE
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
12 (122, 9)
88 (900, 65)
NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET TUBE
EM
TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE
5 (50, 43 in.*lbf)
34 (346, 25)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
ASSEMBLY
71 (720, 53)
48 (490, 35)
12 (122, 9)
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
18 (184, 13)
88 (900, 65)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
88 (900, 65)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119729E04
EM–63
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
EXHAUST PIPE
NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR REAR
GASKET
48 (490, 35)
65 (663, 48)
NO. 3 FRONT
CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
62 (630, 46)
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET
72 (734, 53)
33 (336, 24)
33 (336, 24)
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER RACKET LH
ENGINE UNDER COVER REAR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119730E03
EM
EM–64
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
49 (500, 36)
CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN
COCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
ENGINE REAR OIL
SEAL RETAINER
16 (160, 11)
O-RING
31 (311, 23)
EM
x7
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
O-RING
49 (500, 36)
16 (160, 11)
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
OIL PUMP SEAL
CYLINDER BLOCK WATER
DRAIN COCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
18 (184, 13)
21 (214, 15)
GASKET
x5
18 (184, 13)
WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
A119825E04
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
EM–65
GASKET
OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
EM
OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY (NO. 1)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
28 (290, 31)
OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
x17
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
39 (398, 29)
OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
Non-reusable part
A119930E03
EM–68
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
THROTTLE WITH
MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
18 (180, 13)
HOOD
DAMPER
EM
13 (133, 10)
12 (125, 9)
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
29 (296, 21)
29 (296, 21)
A119814E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–69
RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
EM
FAN SHROUD
NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET HOSE
13 (130, 9)
NO. 1 TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER HOSE
FAN WITH FLUID
COUPLING
FAN PULLEY
29 (296, 21)
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119815E01
EM–70
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
4WD
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
EM
88 (899, 65)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
37 (377, 27) for 14 mm Head
71 (724, 52) for 17 mm Head
88 (899, 65)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119816E01
EM–71
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
2WD
88 (899, 65)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
ASSEMBLY
37 (377, 27) for 14 mm Head
71 (724, 52) for 17 mm Head
EM
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET
OIL COOLER TUBE
12 (122, 9)
DRIVE PLATE & RING
GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
34 (347, 25)
DRIVE PLATE
SPACER REAR
1st: 30 (301, 22)
33 (336, 24)
2nd: Turn 90°
48 (489, 35)
33 (336, 24)
DRIVE PLATE
SPACER FRONT
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER
A137102E01
EM–72
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER
TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
12 (122, 9)
VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
15 (155, 11)
43 (438, 32)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
EM
43 (438, 32)
PUMP BRACKET
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
44 (450, 33)
GASKET
NO. 1 EXHAUST MANIFOLD
HEAT INSULATOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119817E01
EM–73
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
43 (438, 32)
GASKET
GASKET
GASKET
ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR FRONT
62 (632, 46)
62 (632, 46)
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
GASKET
36 (367, 27)
9.8 (100, 86 in.*lbf)
44 (450, 33)
ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR FRONT
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
17 (175, 13)
36 (367, 27)
38 (387, 28)
39 (400, 29)
16 (158, 11)
NO. 2 WIRING
HARNESS HEAT
INSULATOR
47 (475, 34)
39 (400, 29)
7.5 (76, 69 in.*lbf)
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR STAY
25 (255, 18)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 2 EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT INSULATOR
Non-reusable part
A119818E01
EM
EM–74
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
EM
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
GASKET
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
6.5 (65, 58 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
18 (183, 13)
OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY WITH OIL FILTER
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
OIL COOLER PIPE
NO. 3 TIMING BELT COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119819E03
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–75
ENGINE WIRE
VSV FOR AIR
INJECTION SYSTEM
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR
18 (185, 13)
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
NO. 2 FUEL HOSE
NO. 7 WATER
BY-PASS HOSE
FUEL HOSE
INTAKE MANIFOLD
ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 FUEL PIPE CLAMP
NO. 1 FUEL PIPE CLAMP
GASKET
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119820E08
EM
EM–76
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 AIR TUBE
10 (102, 7)
10 (102, 7)
GASKET
GASKET
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
EM
O-RING
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
NO. 3 AIR TUBE
10 (102, 7)
GASKET
WATER INLET HOUSING
WATER BY-PASS JOINT FR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A130721E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–77
AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
16 (163, 12)
EM
STARTER ASSEMBLY
18 (185, 13)
9.8 (100, 7.2)
NO. 2 ENGINE WIRE
O-RING
WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119821E01
EM–78
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
KNOCK SENSOR
20 (204, 15)
VVT SENSOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
VENTILATION VALVE COVER
EM
39 (400, 29)
VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
IGNITION COIL
ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
A119927E01
EM–79
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
16 (160, 12)
16 (160, 12)
EM
FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
32 (326, 24)
NO. 1 TIMING BELT COVER
NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
245 (2,498, 181)
COVER PLATE
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
39 (398, 24)
DUST BOOT
NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 CHAIN TENSHONER ASSEMBLY
26 (270, 19)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119822E08
EM–80
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSEMBLY
PLATE WASHER
35 (352, 25)
CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
EM
8.1 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
8.1 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
TIMING BELT
CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR PLATE
35 (352, 25)
NO. 2 TIMING BELT IDLER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TIMING GEAR COVER SPACER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN COVER GASKET
Precoated part
A119928E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–107
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
• Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all
sliding and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets, O-rings and oil seals with new ones.
1.
REMOVE ENGINE HANGERS
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine hangers.
2.
REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 water drain cocks.
3.
REMOVE SPARK PLUG
4.
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP HOUSING
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and oil filler cap housing.
6.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 9 bolts, 9 seal washers, cylinder head
cover and gasket.
7.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the 9 bolts, 9 seal washers, cylinder head
cover and gasket.
A072687
A072688
A072689
A072690
EM
EM–108
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
8.
REMOVE NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the pulley bolt, cover plate and idler pulley.
9.
REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and timing belt cover.
A072691
EM
A054467
10. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and belt tensioner.
A072692
11. REMOVE FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and fan bracket.
A134365
12. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-70011 (90105-08076), 09330-00021
SST
A054468E03
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–109
(b) Using SST, remove the crankshaft pulley.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05021)
SST
A054470E02
13. REMOVE NO. 1 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
EM
A072694
14. REMOVE TIMING GEAR COVER SPACER
(a) Remove the cover spacer and gasket.
A072695E01
15. REMOVE NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
PLATE
(a) Remove No. 1 crankshaft position sensor plate.
A072696E01
16. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
(a) If reusing the timing belt, check the installation
marks on the timing belt.
(1) Check that there are 3 installation marks on the
timing belt by turning the crankshaft as shown
in the illustration.
If the installation marks have disappeared, put
a new installation mark on the timing belt
before removing each part.
A054457
EM–110
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft to align the timing marks of the
crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
Turn
A054456E01
(c) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys and timing belt plates are aligned.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°).
EM
A054008
Approx. 45°
Turn
Timing Mark
A054461E05
17. REMOVE TIMING BELT
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to approx. 45° BTDC/
compression.
(1) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft counterclockwise by approx. 45°.
NOTICE:
If the timing belt is disengaged, having the
crankshaft pulley at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to
come into contact with each other when
removing the camshaft timing pulley and
camshaft, causing damage. So always set
the crankshaft pulley at the correct angle.
(b) Alternately loosen the 2 bolts, then remove the
bolts, chain tensioner and dust boot.
A072697
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–111
(c) Using SST, loosen the tension between the
camshaft timing pulley (RH bank) and crankshaft
timing pulley by slightly turning the camshaft timing
pulley (RH bank) counterclockwise.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00350)
(d) Disconnect the timing belt from the No. 1 timing belt
idler and remove the timing belt.
SST
Slightly
Turn
A054459E02
18. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(a) Hold the crankshaft with a wrench, and remove the
8 bolts and 2 timing pulleys.
RH Bank:
EM
LH Bank:
A134373E01
19. REMOVE NO. 1 TIMING BELT IDLER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the bolt,
idler and plate washer.
A072698
20. REMOVE NO. 2 TIMING BELT IDLER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and idler.
A072699
EM–112
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
21. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Using SST, remove the timing pulley.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05010)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the timing pulley.
22. REMOVE NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 rear timing belt plate
RH.
SST
A072700E01
23. REMOVE REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Remove the bolt, stud bolt and rear timing belt plate
RH.
24. REMOVE NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 rear timing belt plate
LH.
25. REMOVE REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Remove the bolt and rear timing belt plate LH.
EM
26. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small,
the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the
portion of the cylinder head which receives the shaft
thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the
camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the
following steps should be carried out.
Service Bolt
A054149E01
(a) Remove the camshafts of the RH bank.
(1) In order to install a service bolt to the sub and
main gears, turn the camshaft with a wrench.
The hexagonal portion of the camshaft is used
for turning the camshaft with the wrench.
(2) Secure the sub-gear to the main gear with a
service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm (0.63 to 0.79 in.)
HINT:
When removing the camshafts, make sure that
the torsional spring force of the sub-gear has
been eliminated by the above operation.
EM–113
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(3) Set the timing mark (1-dot mark) of the
camshaft main gear at approx. 10° angle by
turning the hexagonal portion of the exhaust
camshaft with a wrench.
A054150
2
17
18
15
13
14
8
22
5
20
19
6
4
16
10
9
7
12
11
21
3
(4) Uniformly loosen the 22 bearing cap bolts in the
order shown in the illustration, then remove all
the bolts.
(5) Remove the oil feed pipe, 9 bearing caps, oil
control valve filter, camshaft housing plug and 2
camshafts.
1
EM
A054151E01
(b) Remove the camshafts on the LH bank.
(1) In order to install a service bolt to the sub and
main gears, turn the camshaft with a wrench.
The hexagonal portion of the camshaft is used
for turning the camshaft with the wrench.
(2) Secure the sub-gear to the main gear with a
service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Service Bolt
Thread diameter
A054152E01
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm (0.63 to 0.79 in.)
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make sure that
the torsional spring force of the sub-gear has
eliminated by the above operation.
(3) Align the timing marks (2-dot marks) of the
camshaft drive and driven gears by turning the
hexagonal portion of the exhaust camshaft with
a wrench.
Align
A054153E02
EM–114
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
2
21
22
5
20
19
17
15
6
4
1
16
12
3
14
10
11
EM
13
18
8
9
7
27. REMOVE SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
A054154E01
28. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Uniformly loosen the 10 cylinder head bolts on one
side of each cylinder head in several steps, in the
order shown in the illustration. Likewise, loosen the
10 bolts on the other side. Remove the 20 cylinder
head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
• Cylinder head warpage or cracking may
result from removing bolts in incorrect order.
• Do not drop the plate washer for cylinder
head bolt into portion A of the cylinder head.
If dropped into portion A, the plate washer
will pass through the cylinder head and
cylinder block into the oil pan.
RH Cylinder Head:
9
6
4
5
3
10
LH Cylinder Head:
8
2
Front
5
3
1
7
A
2
8
10
(4) Uniformly loosen the 22 bearing cap bolts in the
order shown in the illustration, then remove all
the bolts.
(5) Remove the oil feed pipe, 9 bearing caps, oil
control valve filter, camshaft housing plug and 2
camshafts.
HINT:
Arrange the bearing caps in the correct order.
A
4
6
9
7
1
A072703E01
A002871
(b) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the
cylinder block, and place the 2 cylinder heads on
wooden blocks on a bench.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the contact
surfaces of the cylinder head and cylinder
block.
• The cylinder head should not be tilted so as
to secure the valve lifter. If the cylinder head
is tilted, remove the valve lifter and check that
the adjusting shim is set correctly.
HINT:
If the cylinder head cannot be lifted easily, pry
between the cylinder head and cylinder block with a
screwdriver.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–115
29. REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts, 2 stud bolts, nut, water pump
and gasket.
A134374
SST
A072704E01
30. REMOVE NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 17 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Insert the blade of SST between the oil pan and No.
2 oil pan, and cut off applied sealer. Remove the No.
2 oil pan.
SST 09032-00100
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the contact surface
of the oil pan and the No. 2 oil pan.
• Be careful not to damage the No. 2 oil pan
flange.
31. REMOVE OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and baffle plate.
A072705
32. REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 18 bolts and 2 nuts.
A072706
EM
EM–116
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying
between the oil pan and cylinder block in the order
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the contact
surfaces of the cylinder block or oil pan.
Pry
EM
A072707E01
33. REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
A072708
34. REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 7 bolts and stud bolt.
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to tighten the hexagon
head bolt.
6 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
B013038E03
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pump by prying
the portions between the oil pump and cylinder
block.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of
the cylinder block and oil pump.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the cylinder block.
B002617
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–117
35. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
(a) Remove the 7 bolts.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal retainer by
prying the portions between the oil seal retainer and
crankshaft bearing cap.
(c) Remove the O-ring.
Pry
A005086E01
Bend
36. REMOVE SPARK PLUG TUBE GASKET
(a) Bend the 4 ventilation case claws installed on the
cylinder head cover to an angle of 90° or more.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the gasket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head
cover. Tape the screwdriver tip.
Pry
EM
Claw
A004107E01
Do not remove
A054961E02
37. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
• Do not remove the 4 bolts shown in the
illustration. If any of them are loosened or
removed, the backlash of the gear in the
timing tube will go out of adjustment. In this
case, replace the timing tube assembly with a
new one.
(b) Remove the screw plug and seal washer.
(c) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, and remove the
bolt.
(d) Pull out the timing tube and drive gear assembly
from the camshaft.
10 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
A054962E02
(e) Using SST and a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove
the 4 bolts, drive gear and oil seal.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing tube.
5 mm Hexagon
Wrench
SST
A054965E03
EM–118
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
38. REMOVE CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A054968
(b) Using SST, turn the sub gear clockwise, and remove
the service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
Recommended service bolt:
Turn
Service Bolt
SST
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm (0.63 to 0.79 in.)
EM
A054969E01
(c) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(d) Remove the wave washer, sub gear and gear
spring.
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft sub gears and gear spring
(RH and LH sides).
A054970
39. REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil pump body.
Tape the screwdriver tip.
A054145E01
40. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil
seal.
41. REMOVE VALVE LIFTER
(a) Remove the valve lifter and adjusting shim.
HINT:
Arrange the valve lifters and shims in the correct
order.
A054147
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–119
42. REMOVE INTAKE VALVE
(a) Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove
the 2 valve spring retainer locks.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-01010)
(b) Remove the spring retainer, valve spring, valve and
spring seat.
HINT:
Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats and
spring retainers in the correct order.
SST
A050250E02
43. REMOVE EXHAUST VALVE
(a) Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove
the 2 valve spring retainer locks.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
(b) Remove the spring retainer, valve spring, valve and
spring seat.
HINT:
Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats and
spring retainers in the correct order.
SST
A050249E02
44. REMOVE VALVE STEM OIL SEAL
(a) Using needle-nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
A003192
A005100
45. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.160 to 0.290 mm (0.0063 to 0.0114 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the connecting rod assembly. If necessary,
replace the crankshaft.
Connecting rod thickness (Reference):
22.880 to 22.920 mm (0.9008 to 0.9024 in.)
EM
EM–120
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
46. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Check the matchmarks on the connecting rod and
cap to ensure correct reassembly.
(b) Remove the 2 connecting rod cap bolts.
A005104
EM
A005105
(c) Using the removed connecting rod cap bolts,
remove the connecting rod cap and lower bearing
by wiggling the connecting rod cap right and left.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing inserted with the connecting
rod cap.
(d) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(e) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the crank pin or bearing is damaged, replace the
bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(f)
Plastigage
Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
A005102E01
(g) Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the
connecting rod.
(h) Align the pin groove of the connecting rod cap with
the pins of the connecting rod, and install the
connecting rod cap.
A005106
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(i)
LH Bank:
Front
EM–121
Check that the outside mark of the connecting rod
cap is facing in the correct direction.
HINT:
• The connecting rod cap bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps.
• If any one of the connecting rod cap bolts is
broken or deformed, replace it.
Outside Mark (Protrusion)
RH Bank:
Front
EM
Outside Mark (Protrusion)
A005174E02
(j)
A005101
90°
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
(k) Install and alternately tighten the 2 connecting rod
cap bolts in several steps.
Torque: 25 N*m (250 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
If any one of the connecting rod cap bolts does not
meet the torque specification, replace the
connecting rod cap bolts.
(l) Mark the front of the connecting cap bolts with paint.
(m) Retighten the cap bolts 90° as shown in the
illustration.
(n) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to
the front.
90°
Front
Painted
Mark
A005099E02
(o) Remove the 2 bolts, connecting rod cap and lower
bearing.
A005101
EM–122
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(p) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.021 to 0.047 mm (0.0008 to 0.0019 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.065 mm (0.0026 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the bearings. If necessary, replace the
crankshaft.
HINT:
If using a standard bearing, replace it with one
having the same number. If the number of the
bearing cannot be determined, add together the
numbers imprinted on the connecting rod cap and
crankshaft, then select the bearing with the same
number as the total. There are 6 sizes of standard
bearings, marked "2", "3", "4", "5", "6" and "7".
Number Mark
Item
No. 4
EM
No. 1
No. 3
No. 2
Number Mark
Number Mark
Number Mark
Connecting rod cap
1
1
2
1
2
3
2
3
4
3
4
4
Crankshaft
1
2
1
3
2
1
3
2
1
3
2
3
Use bearing
2
3
4
5
6
7
EXAMPLE:
Connecting rod cap "3" + Crankshaft "1" = Total
number 4 (Use bearing "4")
Connecting rod big end inside diameter:
Mark "1"
55.000 to 55.006 mm (2.1654 to 2.1656 in.)
Mark "2"
55.006 to 55.012 mm (2.1656 to 2.1658 in.)
Mark "3"
55.012 to 55.018 mm (2.1658 to 2.1661 in.)
Mark "4"
55.018 to 55.024 mm (2.1661 to 2.1663 in.)
Crankshaft crank pin diameter:
A139502E01
Mark "1"
51.994 to 52.000 mm (2.0470 to 2.0472 in.)
Mark "2"
51.988 to 51.994 mm (2.0468 to 2.0470 in.)
Mark "3"
51.982 to 51.988 mm (2.0465 to 2.0468 in.)
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
Mark "2"
1.487 to 1.490 mm (0.0585 to 0.0587 in.)
Mark "3"
1.490 to 1.493 mm (0.0587 to 0.0588 in.)
Mark "4"
1.493 to 1.496 mm (0.0588 to 0.0589 in.)
Mark "5"
1.496 to 1.499 mm (0.0589 to 0.0590 in.)
Mark "6"
1.499 to 1.502 mm (0.0590 to 0.0591 in.)
Mark "7"
1.502 to 1.505 mm (0.0591 to 0.0593 in.)
(q) Completely remove the Plastigage.
Ridge Reamer
A054348E02
47. REMOVE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
(a) Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from
the top of the cylinder.
(b) Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and
upper bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
HINT:
• Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap
together.
• Arrange the piston and connecting rod
assemblies in the correct order.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–123
48. REMOVE PISTON
(a) Check the fitting condition between the piston and
piston pin.
(1) Try to move the piston back and forth on the
piston pin.
If any movement is felt, replace the piston and
pin as a set.
A004862
(b) Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 piston
rings.
(c) Remove the oil ring (2 side rails and expander) by
hand.
HINT:
Arrange the piston rings in the correct order.
EM
A004873
(d) Using a screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
A004860
(e) Gradually heat the piston to approx. 60°C (140°F).
A004887
(f)
A004888
Using a plastic hammer and brass bar, lightly tap
out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
HINT:
• The piston and pin are a matched set.
• Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods
and bearings in the correct order.
EM–124
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
A005096
7
9
STD
2.440 to 2.490 mm (0.0961 to 0.0980 in.)
O/S 0.125
2.503 to 2.553 mm (0.0985 to 0.1005 in.)
50. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 crankshaft
bearing cap bolts in several steps, in the order
shown in the illustration.
3
5
EM
49. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while prying the crankshaft back and forth with a
screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.020 to 0.220 mm (0.0008 to 0.0087 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the thrust washers as a set.
Thrust washer thickness
4
1
10
8
6
2
A005095E01
A005093
(b) Using 2 screwdrivers, pry out the crankshaft bearing
cap, and remove the 5 crankshaft bearing caps, 5
lower bearings and 2 lower thrust washers (No. 3
crankshaft bearing cap only).
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder block.
HINT:
• Keep the lower bearing and crankshaft bearing
cap together.
• Arrange the crankshaft bearing caps and lower
thrust washers in the correct order.
(c) Lift out the crankshaft.
(d) Remove the 2 upper thrust washers.
HINT:
• Arrange the upper thrust washers in the correct
order.
• Keep the upper bearings together with the
cylinder block.
(e) Clean each crankshaft journal and bearing.
(f) Check each crankshaft journal and bearing for
pitting and scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the
bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–125
(g) Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(h) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
Plastigage
A005097E01
(i)
Install the 5 crankshaft bearing caps in their proper
locations.
HINT:
• The crankshaft bearing cap bolts are tightened in
2 progressive steps (Procedures "A" and "B").
• If any one of the main bearing cap bolts is broken
or deformed, replace it.
EM
A005091
(j)
4
2
8
6
7
10
3
1
5
9
A005095E02
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the crankshaft bearing cap bolts.
(k) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 crankshaft
bearing cap bolts in several steps, in the order
shown in the illustration (Procedure "A").
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
If any one of the crankshaft bearing cap bolts does
not meet the torque specification, replace the
crankshaft bearing cap bolt.
(l)
Mark the front of the crankshaft bearing cap bolts
with paint.
(m) Retighten the crankshaft bearing cap bolts by 90° in
the order shown (Procedure "B").
(n) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to
the front.
(o) Remove the crankshaft bearing caps.
90°
90°
Front
Painted
Mark
A005094E02
EM–126
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(p) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard clearance
No. 1 and No. 5
Others
0.028 to 0.046 mm
(0.0011 to 0.0018 in.)
0.040 to 0.058 mm
(0.0016 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum clearance
No. 3
No. 4
No. 5
Number Mark
No. 2
No. 1
Number Mark
EM
No. 5
No. 2
No. 1
No. 1 and No. 5
Others
0.065 mm (0.0026 in.)
0.065 mm (0.0026 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the bearings. If necessary, replace the
crankshaft.
HINT:
If using a standard bearing, replace it with one
having the same number. If the number of the
bearing cannot be determined, add together the
numbers imprinted on the cylinder block and
crankshaft, then refer to the table below for the
appropriate bearing number. There are 5 sizes of
the standard bearings. For No. 1 and No. 5 position
bearings, use bearings marked "3", "4", "5", "6" and
"7". For the other position bearings, use bearings
marked "1", "2", "3", "4" and "5".
No. 1 and No. 5:
-
No. 3
Use bearing
0 to 5
No. 4
Number Mark
A139503E01
Cylinder block (A)
+
Crankshaft (B)
3
6 to 11
4
12 to 17
5
18 to 23
6
24 to 28
7
EXAMPLE:
Cylinder block "08" + Crankshaft "06" = Total
number 14 (Use bearing "5")
Others:
-
Use bearing
0 to 5
Cylinder block (A)
+
Crankshaft (B)
1
6 to 11
2
12 to 17
3
18 to 23
4
24 to 28
5
EXAMPLE:
Cylinder block "08" + Crankshaft "06" = Total
number 14 (Use bearing "3")
Cylinder block crankshaft journal bore diameter (A):
Mark "00"
72.000 mm (2.8347 in.)
Mark "01"
72.001 mm (2.8347 in.)
Mark "02"
72.002 mm (2.8347 in.)
Mark "03"
72.003 mm (2.8348 in.)
Mark "04"
72.004 mm (2.8348 in.)
Mark "05"
72.005 mm (2.8348 in.)
Mark "06"
72.006 mm (2.8349 in.)
EM–127
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Mark "07"
72.007 mm (2.8349 in.)
Mark "08"
72.008 mm (2.8350 in.)
Mark "09"
72.009 mm (2.8350 in.)
Mark "10"
72.010 mm (2.8350 in.)
Mark "11"
72.011 mm (2.8351 in.)
Mark "12"
72.012 mm (2.8351 in.)
Mark "13"
72.013 mm (2.8352 in.)
Mark "14"
72.014 mm (2.8352 in.)
Mark "15"
72.015 mm (2.8352 in.)
Mark "16"
72.016 mm (2.8353 in.)
Crankshaft journal diameter (B):
Mark "00"
67.000 mm (2.6378 in.)
Mark "01"
66.999 mm (2.6378 in.)
Mark "02"
66.998 mm (2.6377 in.)
Mark "03"
66.997 mm (2.6377 in.)
Mark "04"
66.996 mm (2.6376 in.)
Mark "05"
66.995 mm (2.6376 in.)
Mark "06"
66.994 mm (2.6376 in.)
Mark "07"
66.993 mm (2.6375 in.)
Mark "08"
66.992 mm (2.6375 in.)
Mark "09"
66.991 mm (2.6374 in.)
Mark "10"
66.990 mm (2.6374 in.)
Mark "11"
66.989 mm (2.6374 in.)
Mark "12"
66.988 mm (2.6373 in.)
Standard bearing center wall thickness No. 1 and
No. 5:
Mark "3"
2.487 to 2.490 mm (0.0979 to 0.0980 in.)
Mark "4"
2.490 to 2.493 mm (0.0980 to 0.0982 in.)
Mark "5"
2.493 to 2.496 mm (0.0982 to 0.0983 in.)
Mark "6"
2.496 to 2.499 mm (0.0983 to 0.0984 in.)
Mark "7"
2.499 to 2.502 mm (0.0984 to 0.0985 in.)
Others:
Mark "1"
2.481 to 2.484 mm (0.0977 to 0.0978 in.)
Mark "2"
2.484 to 2.487 mm (0.0978 to 0.0979 in.)
Mark "3"
2.487 to 2.490 mm (0.0979 to 0.0980 in.)
Mark "4"
2.490 to 2.493 mm (0.0980 to 0.0982 in.)
Mark "5"
2.493 to 2.496 mm (0.0982 to 0.0983 in.)
(q) Completely remove the Plastigage.
51. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
(a) Lift up the crankshaft.
(b) Remove the 5 upper crankshaft bearings and 2
upper thrust washers from the cylinder block.
HINT:
Arrange the crankshaft bearing caps, bearings and
thrust washers in the correct order.
52. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY SET
CRANKSHAFT KEY
EM
EM–128
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
INSPECTION
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
• Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all
sliding and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets, O-rings and oil seals with new ones.
1.
INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
• Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside
out.
• Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact
with oil, water or steam.
• Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing
or removing the mount bolt of the camshaft timing
pulley.
If there are any defects as shown in the illustration,
check the following points:
(a) If premature parting occurs, check the following:
• Check for proper installation.
• Check the timing cover gasket for damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, inspect the
camshaft.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face,
check if there are nicks on the side of the idler pulley
lock and water pump.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the
belt, check the belt guide and alignment of each
pulley.
(e) If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check
for damage on the timing belt or foreign objects on
the pulley teeth. Check if the gasket is installed
correctly.
If necessary, replace the timing belt.
2.
INSPECT NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check the seal portion of the tensioner for
oil leakage.
HINT:
If there is a faint trace of oil on the seal on the push
rod side, the tensioner is all right.
If leakage is found, replace the tensioner.
EM
A054954
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–129
(b) Hold the tensioner by hands and push the push rod
strongly as shown in the illustration to check that it
does not move.
If the push rod moves, replace the tensioner.
NOTICE:
Do not face the tensioner push rod downward.
A054955
(c) Measure the protrusion of the push rod from the
housing end.
Protrusion:
11.2 to 12.2 mm (0.440 to 0.480 in.)
If the protrusion is not as specified, replace the
tensioner.
Protrusion
EM
A054956E01
3.
INSPECT TIMING BELT IDLER
(a) Visually check the seal portion of the idler pulley for
oil leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the idler pulley.
(b) Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler.
4.
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thread outside
diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
9.810 to 9.960 mm (0.3862 to 0.3921 in.)
Minimum outside diameter:
9.700 mm (0.3819 in.)
5.
INSPECT CAMSHAFTS
(a) Inspect the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout
at the center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum,
replace the camshaft.
A054957
Measuring Point
75 to 85 mm (2.95 to 3.35 in.)
A002827E01
A005912
EM–130
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Inspect the cam lobes.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe
height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Intake:
41.94 to 42.04 mm (1.6512 to 1.6551 in.)
Exhaust:
41.96 to 42.06 mm (1.6520 to 1.6559 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
Intake:
41.79 mm (1.6453 in.)
Exhaust:
41.81 mm (1.6461 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum,
replace the camshaft.
EM02011
(c) Inspect the camshaft journals.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the journal
diameter.
Journal diameter:
26.954 to 26.970 mm (1.0612 to 1.0618 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check
the oil clearance.
EM
A134375
6.
A134376
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
Journal diameter:
39.955 to 39.964 mm (1.5730 to 1.5734 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the
oil clearance.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–131
(b) Install the timing tube to the intake camshaft, and
check that the timing tube turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the timing tube and intake
camshaft.
Turn
A134377E01
7.
18.2 to 18.8 mm
INSPECT CAMSHAFT GEAR SPRING
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the gap distance of
the gear spring.
Gap distance:
18.2 to 18.8 mm (0.717 to 0.740 in.)
If the gap distance is not as specified, replace the
gear spring.
EM
A053870E01
8.
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the cylinder head.
(1) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket
material from the cylinder block contact
surface.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
A053862
(2) Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from
the combustion chambers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block
contact surface.
A053863
(3) Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent,
clean all the guide bushes.
P021861
EM–132
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(4) Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly
clean the cylinder head.
EM06325
(b) Inspect for warpage.
(1) Using a precision straight edge and feeler
gauge, measure the warpage of the contact
surfaces of the cylinder block and the
manifolds.
Maximum warpage:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum,
replace the cylinder head.
EM
A005592
(c) Inspect for cracks.
(1) Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion
chamber, intake ports, exhaust ports and
cylinder block surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
EM06327
9.
EM00580
INSPECT VALVE
(a) Clean the valves.
(1) Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon
from the valve head.
(2) Using a wire brush, thoroughly clean the valve.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–133
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
valve stem.
Valve stem diameter:
Intake:
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
Exhaust:
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2157 in.)
Z000052E01
(c) Check the valve face angle.
(1) Grind the valve enough to remove pits and
carbon.
(2) Check that the valve is ground to the correct
valve face angle.
Valve face angle:
44.5°
44.5°
EM
Z000054E01
Margin
Thickness
EM00181E02
Overall Length
EM02534E01
(d) Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
Intake:
1.25 mm (0.049 in.)
Exhaust:
1.4 mm (0.055 in.)
Minimum margin thickness:
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
(e) Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length:
Intake:
95.05 mm (3.7421 in.)
Exhaust:
95.10 mm (3.7441 in.)
Minimum overall length:
Intake:
94.55 mm (3.7224 in.)
Exhaust:
94.60 mm (3.7244 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
EM–134
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(f)
Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a
grinder or replace the valve.
NOTICE:
Do not grind off more than the minimum.
A053828E01
10. INSPECT VALVE SPRING
(a) Using a steel square, measure the deviation of the
valve spring.
Maximum deviation:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than the maximum,
replace the valve spring.
EM
EM00988E01
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the free length of
the valve spring.
Free length:
54.1 mm (2.130 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the
valve spring.
EM00801
(c) Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the
valve spring at the specified installed length.
Installed tension:
210 to 226 N (21.4 to 23.0 kgf, 47.2 to 50.7 lbf)
at 35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace
the valve spring.
EM00281
P021862
11. INSPECT VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter
of the guide bush.
Bush inside diameter:
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
(b) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement
from the guide bush inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake:
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust:
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–135
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
Intake:
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the valve and guide bush.
12. REMOVE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C
(176 to 212°F).
80 to 100°C
A003195E01
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bush.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01060), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
A005708E01
13. INSTALL VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore
diameter of the cylinder head.
A003197
Intake
(b) Select a new guide bush (STD or O/S 0.05).
Exhaust
34.5 mm
(1.358 in.)
40.5 mm
(1.594 in.)
P021844E01
Bush bore diameter
Bush size
10.285 to 10.306 mm (0.4049 to 0.4057 in.)
Use STD
10.335 to 10.356 mm (0.4069 to 0.4077 in.)
Use O/S 0.05
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 10.306 mm (0.4057 in.), machine the
bush bore so that the dimension is between 10.335
and 10.356 mm (0.4069 and 0.4077 in.).
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 10.356 mm (0.4077 in.), replace the
cylinder head.
EM
EM–136
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
HINT:
Different bushes are used for the intake and
exhaust.
SST
A005709E01
(c) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C
(176 to 212°F).
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bush
to the specified protrusion height.
Protrusion height:
Intake:
9.2 to 9.8 mm (0.362 to 0.386 in.)
Exhaust:
8.2 to 8.8 mm (0.323 to 0.346 in.)
SST 09201-01055, 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
(e) Using a sharp 5.5mm reamer, ream the guide bush
to obtain the specified clearance between the guide
bush and valve stem.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01060), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Sharp 5.5 mm Reamer
EM
A003200E01
45° Carbide
Cutter
14. INSPECT VALVE SEAT
(a) Using a 45° carbide cutter, resurface the valve
seats. Clean metal filings from the valve seats.
EM06330E01
Width
Z000055E01
(b) Check the valve seating position.
(1) Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white
lead) to the valve face.
(2) Lightly press the valve against the seat. Do not
rotate valve.
(c) Check the valve face and seat for the following:
(1) If prussian blue appears around the entire face,
the valve is centered. If not, replace the valve.
(2) If prussian blue appears around the entire
valve seat, the guide and face are centered. If
not, resurface the seat.
(3) Check that the seat contacts in the middle of
the valve face with the following width:
Width:
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
45°
30°
EM–137
15. REPAIR VALVE SEAT
(a) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 30°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
1.0 to 1.4 mm
A066652E01
60°
(b) If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 60°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
45°
EM
1.0 to 1.4 mm
Z003989E01
(c) Handrub the valve and valve seat with an abrasive
compound.
(d) After handrubbing, clean the valve and valve seat.
EM06331
16. INSPECT VALVE LIFTER
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore
diameter of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.000 to 31.016 mm (1.2205 to 1.2211 in.)
A003209
12.3 to 12.7 mm
A053835E02
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter
where the distance from the top surface is 12.3 to
12.7 mm (0.484 to 0.500 in.).
Lifter diameter:
30.968 to 30.976 mm (1.2192 to 1.2195 in.)
(c) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the
lifter bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 to 0.050 mm (0.0009 to 0.0020 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
EM–138
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the lifter. If necessary, replace the cylinder
head.
Plastigage
A134380E01
17. INSPECT CAMSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Install the camshaft timing tube to the camshaft
(See page EM-160).
(b) Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
(c) Check the bearings for flaking and scoring.
If the bearings are damaged, replace the bearing
caps and cylinder head as a set.
(d) Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(e) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the
camshaft journals.
(f)
EM
Install the bearing caps (See page EM-168).
Torque: For bolt A
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
For others
16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshaft.
(g) Remove the bearing caps.
A
A
A134381E01
(h) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance
Camshaft journal
Camshaft timing tube journal
0.030 to 0.071 mm
(0.0012 to 0.0028 in.)
0.036 to 0.057 mm
(0.0014 to 0.0022 in.)
Maximum oil clearance
Camshaft journal
Camshaft timing tube journal
0.100 mm (0.0039 in.)
0.075 mm (0.0030 in.)
A134382
(i)
(j)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the
bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
Remove the camshafts.
Completely remove the Plastigage.
18. INSPECT CAMSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Install the camshaft (See page EM-168).
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance
A134383
Intake
Exhaust
0 to 0.040 mm
(0 to 0.0016 in.)
0.030 to 0.070 mm
(0.0012 to 0.0028 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance
Intake
Exhaust
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–139
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the
bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
(c) Remove the camshafts.
(d) Remove the camshaft timing tube from the intake
camshaft.
A134384
19. INSPECT CAMSHAFT GEAR BACKLASH
(a) Install the drive gear to the camshaft timing tube
(See page EM-160).
(b) Install the camshaft timing tube to the intake
camshaft (See page EM-160).
(c) Install the camshafts without installing the exhaust
camshaft sub-gear No. 3 and front bearing cap (See
page EM-160).
(d) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash.
Standard backlash:
0.020 to 0.200 mm (0.0008 to 0.0079 in.)
Maximum backlash:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the backlash is greater than the maximum,
replace the intake camshaft drive gear and exhaust
camshaft.
(e) Remove the camshafts.
(f) Remove the camshaft timing tube from the intake
camshaft.
(g) Remove the drive gear from the camshaft timing
tube.
20. CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket
material from the top surface of the cylinder block.
(b) Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the
cylinder block.
A004849
EM
EM–140
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
21. INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect for warpage.
(1) Using a precision straight edge and feeler
gauge, measure the warpage of the contact
surfaces of the cylinder head and crankshaft
bearing cap.
Maximum warpage:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum,
replace the cylinder block sub-assembly.
Cylinder Head Side
EM
Crankshaft Bearing Cap Side
A074955E02
(b) Visually check the cylinder for vertical scratches.
If deep scratches are present, rebore all the 8
cylinders and replace all the 8 pistons. If necessary,
replace the cylinder block.
A004853
(c) Inspect the cylinder bore diameter.
HINT:
There are 3 sizes of the standard cylinder bore
diameter, marked "1", "2" and "3" accordingly. The
mark is stamped on the top of the cylinder block.
No. 2 No. 4 No. 6 No. 8
Front
No. 1 No .3 No. 5 No. 7
Mark 1, 2 or 3
A074956E01
EM–141
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Thrust Direction
Front
(1) Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder
bore diameter at positions A and B in the thrust
and axial directions.
Standard diameter
Axial Direction
A
B
10 mm
(0.39 in)
STD
Mark "1"
Mark "2"
Mark "3"
94.002 to 94.010 mm
(3.7009 to 3.7012 in.)
94.010 to 94.023 mm
(3.7012 to 3.7017 in.)
94.023 to 94.031 mm
(3.7017 to 3.7020 in.)
Maximum diameter:
94.230 mm (3.5917 in.)
If the diameter is greater than the maximum,
rebore all the 8 cylinders and replace all the 8
pistons. If necessary, replace the cylinder
block.
Center
STD
94.231 mm (3.7099 in.)
O/S 0.50
94.731 mm (3.7296 in.)
EM
A005181E02
(d) Remove the cylinder ridge.
If the wear is less than 0.2mm (0.008 in.), using a
ridge reamer, grind the top of the cylinder.
Ridge Reamer
A004852E01
22. INSPECT PISTON
(a) Clean the piston.
(1) Using a gasket scraper, remove the carbon
from the piston top.
A004877
(2) Using a groove cleaning tool or broken ring,
clean the piston ring grooves.
A004878
EM–142
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(3) Using solvent and a brush, thoroughly clean
the piston.
NOTICE:
Do not use a wire brush.
A004879
Mark 2
LH Piston
30.75 mm
EM
(b) Inspect the piston oil clearance.
HINT:
There are 3 sizes of the standard piston diameter,
marked "1", "2" or "3" accordingly. The mark is
stamped on the piston top.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the piston
diameter at right angles to the piston pin center
line, 30.75 mm (1.2106 in.) from the piston
head.
Piston diameter
O/S 0.50
RH Piston
94.402 to 94.430
mm
(3.7168 to 3.7177
in.)
Mark 2
A134386E01
STD
Mark "1"
Mark "2"
Mark "3"
93.902 to 93.912
mm
(3.6969 to 3.6973
in.)
93.912 to 93.920
mm
(3.6973 to 3.6976
in.)
93.920 to 93.930
mm
(3.6976 to 3.6980
in.)
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(2) Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the
thrust directions.
(3) Subtract the piston diameter measurement
from the cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.090 to 0.111 mm (0.0035 to 0.0044 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace all the 8 pistons and rebore
all the 8 cylinders. If necessary, replace the
cylinder block.
HINT:
Use a new cylinder block:
• Use a piston with the same number mark as
the cylinder diameter marked on the cylinder
block.
• The shape of the piston varies for the LH
and RH banks. The LH piston is marked with
1 cavity and "2", the RH piston with 2
cavities and "2".
No. 2 No. 4 No. 6 No. 8
Front
No. 1 No .3 No. 5 No. 7
LH Piston
EM–143
Mark 2
Mark 2
RH Piston
Mark 2
A134387E01
(c) Inspect the piston pin fit.
(1) Heat the piston to approx. 60° C (140° F), and
push the piston pin into the piston pin hole with
your thumb.
60°C
A004048E03
(d) Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin
diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
EM00227
EM
EM–144
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
23. INSPECT PISTON RING SET
(a) Inspect the piston ring groove clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the new piston ring and the wall of the
ring groove.
Ring groove clearance
No. 1
No. 2
0.030 to 0.080 mm
(0.0012 to 0.0032 in.)
0.020 to 0.060 mm
(0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
A004880
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the
piston.
(b) Inspect the piston ring end gap.
(1) Insert the piston ring into the cylinder bore.
(2) Using a piston, push the piston ring a little
beyond the bottom of the ring travel, 105 mm
(4.13 in.) from the top of the cylinder block.
EM
105 mm
A004872E02
(3) Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap
No. 1
No. 2
Oil (Side rail)
0.300 to 0.400 mm
(0.0118 to 0.0158 in.)
0.400 to 0.550 mm
(0.0158 to 0.0217 in.)
0.130 to 0.380 mm
(0.0051 to 0.0150 in.)
Maximum end gap
No. 1
No. 2
Oil (Side rail)
1.10 mm (0.0433 in.)
1.30 mm (0.0512 in.)
0.90 mm (0.0354 in.)
EM07639
If the end gap is greater than the maximum,
replace the piston ring. If the end gap is greater
than the maximum, even with a new piston ring,
rebore all the 8 cylinders or replace the cylinder
block sub-assembly.
24. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the
connecting rod alignment.
(1) Check for bend.
Maximum bend:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If bend is greater than the maximum, replace
the connecting rod sub-assembly.
100 mm
Z014454E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–145
(2) Check for twist.
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If twist is greater than the maximum, replace
the connecting rod sub-assembly.
100 mm
Z014455E01
(b) Inspect the piston pin oil clearance.
(1) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside
diameter of the connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
EM
EM06525
EM00227
(2) Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin
diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
(3) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement
from the bushing inside diameter
measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the connecting rod subassembly. If necessary, replace the piston and
piston pin as a set.
25. REMOVE CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the bushing.
SST 09222-30010
EM06363E01
EM–146
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
26. INSTALL CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
(a) Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the
connecting rod.
A051812E01
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the bushing.
SST 09222-30010
EM
EM06363E01
(c) Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain
the specified clearance between the bushing and
piston pin.
EM06535
(d) Check the piston pin fit at normal room temperature.
Coat the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into
the connecting rod with your thumb.
P000326
Tension Portion
A004223E01
27. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the tension portion
diameter of the connecting rod bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.200 to 7.300 mm (0.2835 to 0.2874 in.)
Minimum diameter:
7.00 mm (0.2756 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
bolt.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–147
28. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT BEARING CAP BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thread outside
diameter of the crankshaft bearing cap bolt.
Standard diameter:
10.760 to 10.970 mm (0.4236 to 0.4319 in.)
Minimum diameter:
10.40 mm (0.4094 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
cap bolt.
50 to 64 mm (1.97 to 2.52 in.)
A066653E01
29. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT
(a) Inspect for circle runout.
(1) Place the crankshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout
at the center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.04 mm (0.0016 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the
maximum, replace the crankshaft.
A005121
(b) Inspect the crankshaft journals and crank pins.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of
each crankshaft journal and crank pin.
Crankshaft journal diameter:
66.988 to 67.000 mm (2.6373 to 2.6378 in.)
Crank pin diameter:
51.982 to 52.000 mm (2.0465 to 2.0472 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil
clearance. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(2) Check each crankshaft journal and crank pin
for taper and out-of-round as shown in the
illustration.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out-of-round is greater than the
maximum, replace the crankshaft.
A005169E01
EM
EM–94
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
ENGINE UNIT
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
EM
16 (163, 12)
STARTER ASSEMBLY
18 (185, 13)
9.8 (100, 7.2)
NO. 2 ENGINE WIRE
O-RING
WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119821E02
EM–95
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
KNOCK SENSOR
20 (204, 15)
VVT SENSOR
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
VENTILATION VALVE COVER
EM
39 (400, 29)
VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
IGNITION COIL
ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
A119927E02
EM–96
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
16 (160, 12)
16 (160, 12)
EM
FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
32 (326, 24)
NO. 1 TIMING BELT COVER
NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
245 (2,498, 181)
COVER PLATE
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
39 (398, 24)
DUST BOOT
NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
26 (270, 19)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119822E09
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–97
NO. 1 TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSEMBLY
PLATE WASHER
35 (352, 25)
CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
EM
8.1 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
8.1 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
TIMING BELT
CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR PLATE
35 (352, 25)
NO. 2 TIMING BELT IDLER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TIMING GEAR COVER SPACER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 2 TIMING CHAIN COVER GASKET
Precoated part
A119928E02
EM–98
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
6.0 (60, 53 in.*lbf)
x9
GASKET
EM
OIL FEED PIPE
16 (163, 12)
FRONT BEARING CAP
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT
DRIVE GEAR
CAMSHAFT
CAMSHAFT TIMING
TUBE ASSEMBLY
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
15 (152, 11)
SCREW PLUG
CAMSHAFT SETTING OIL SEAL
78 (795, 58)
SEAL WASHER
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT
SUB GEAR
CAMSHAFT GEAR SPRING
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
SHAFT SNAP RING
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
WAVE WASHER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119823E05
EM–99
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
*1
1st: 40 (408, 30)
2nd: Turn 90°
3rd: Turn 90°
OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
x10
SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
NO. 1 ENGINE HANGER
EM
37 (380, 27)
CAMSHAFT HOUSING PLUG
CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
*1: See paragraph REASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119929E01
EM–100
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
OIL FILTER CAP
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
18 (178, 13)
SPARK PLUG
EM
OIL FILLER CAP HOUSING
GASKET
6.0 (60, 53 in.*lbf)
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
x9
GASKET
SPARK PLUG TUBE GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119824E01
EM–101
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
FRONT BEARING CAP
16 (163, 12)
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CAMSHAFT SETTING OIL SEAL
CAMSHAFT TIMING TUBE ASSEMBLY
16 (160, 12)
78 (795, 58)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
SEAL WASHER
15 (152, 11)
CAMSHAFT OIL FEED
PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
SCREW PLUG
BEARING CAP
CAMSHAFT DRIVE GEAR
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR WAVE WASHER
NO. 4 CAMSHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR SHAFT SNAP RING
CAMSHAFT HOUSING PLUG
CAMSHAFT GEAR SPRING
37 (380, 27)
x10
NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
NO. 1 ENGINE HANGER
1st: 40 (408, 30)
*1
OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
2nd: Turn 90°
3rd: Turn 90°
SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
CYLINDER HEAD LH
NO. 2 CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
*1: See paragraph REASSEMBLY
A130722E04
EM
EM–102
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
49 (500, 36)
CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN
COCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
ENGINE REAR OIL
SEAL RETAINER
16 (160, 11)
O-RING
31 (311, 23)
EM
x7
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
O-RING
49 (500, 36)
16 (160, 11)
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
OIL PUMP SEAL
CYLINDER BLOCK WATER
DRAIN COCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
18 (184, 13)
21 (214, 15)
GASKET
x5
18 (184, 13)
WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
A119825E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–103
GASKET
OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
EM
OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY (NO. 1)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
28 (290, 31)
OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
x17
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
39 (398, 29)
OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
Non-reusable part
A119930E01
EM–104
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
CYLINDER HEAD RH
VALVE LIFTER
VALVE ADJUST SHIM
VALVE SPRING RETAINER LOCK
EM
VALVE SPRING RETAINER
VALVE SPRING
VALVE SPRING SEAT
OIL SEAL
VALVE GUIDE BUSH
VALVE
RING PIN
9.0 (90, 80 in.*lbf)
STUD BOLT
CYLINDER HEAD LH
TIGHT PLUG
RING PIN
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
15 (150, 11)
Precoated part
A119826E04
EM–105
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
SIDE RAIL
OIL RING
NO. 1 PISTON RING
EXPANDER
SIDE RAIL
NO. 2 PISTON RING
SNAP RING
PISTON
SNAP RING
PISTON PIN
CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
CONNECTING ROD
*1
1st: 25 (250, 18)
CONNECTING ROD BEARING
2nd: Turn 90°
CONNECTING ROD BEARING CAP
*1: See paragraph REASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119827E04
EM
EM–106
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
TIGHT PLUG
20 (200, 14)
STUD BOLT
CYLINDER BLOCK
RING PIN
RING PIN
EM
TIGHT PLUG
12 (120, 9)
STUD BOLT
20 (200, 14)
STUD BOLT
UPPER CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER
14 (145, 10)
STUD BOLT
UPPER CRANKSHAFT
BEARING
CRANKSHAFT
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY SET
CRANKSHAFT KEY
LOWER CRANKSHAFT
THRUST WASHER
LOWER CRANKSHAFT BEARING
*1
1st: 27 (275, 20)
CRANKSHAFT BEARING CAP
2nd: Turn 90°
*1: See paragraph REASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
A119931E01
EM–148
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
• Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all
sliding and rotating surfaces.
• Replace all gaskets, O-rings and oil seals with new ones.
1.
INSTALL TIGHT PLUG
(a) Install the tight plug.
EM
A072720E01
(1) Apply adhesive to the tight plug.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three
Bond 1324 or equivalent
(2) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new tight
plug as shown in the illustration.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00350), 0995070010 (09951-07100)
SST
A072721E01
EM–149
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
2.
INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Install the stud bolt.
D
E
A
C
B
B
E
D
15 mm
(0.59 in.)
EM
16 mm
(0.63 in.)
120 mm
(4.72 in.)
116 mm
(4.57 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
35 mm
(1.38 in.)
15 mm
(0.59 in.)
A
(Thread diameter: 8 mm)
37 mm
(1.46 in.)
20 mm
(0.79 in.)
B
(Thread diameter: 10 mm)
15 mm
(0.59 in.)
14 mm
(0.55 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
32 mm
(1.26 in.)
C
(Thread diameter: 8 mm)
D
(Thread diameter: 8 mm)
7.5 mm
(0.30 in.)
24 mm
(0.94 in.)
E
(Thread diameter: 8 mm)
G039840E01
Torque: For A
8.0 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
For B
20 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
For C
12 N*m (120 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
For D
14 N*m (145 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
For E
8.0 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 71 ft.*lbf)
EM–150
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
3.
INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Install the straight pin.
Until pin stops
10 mm (0.39 in.)
6 mm (0.24 in.)
B
B
A
22 mm
(0.87 in.)
14 mm
(0.55 in.)
A
A
B
A053947E02
EM
4.
INSTALL RING PIN
(a) Install the ring pin.
A
A
C
B
C
C
C
B
A
Until pin stops
13 mm
(0.51 in.)
11 mm
(0.43 in.)
20 mm
(0.79 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
8 mm
(0.31 in.)
A
16 mm
(0.63 in.)
B
C
A134388E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
5.
EM–151
INSTALL PISTON
(a) Using a screwdriver, install a new snap ring on one
side of the piston pin hole.
A004861
(b) Gradually heat the piston to about 60°C (140°F).
60°C
EM
A004876E02
(c) Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
(d) Position the piston front mark with respect to the
outside mark on the connecting rod as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
The installation directions of the piston and
connecting rod are different for the LH and RH
banks. The LH piston is marked with 1 cavity
and "2", the RH piston with 2 cavities and "2".
(e) Align the piston pin holes of the piston and
connecting rod, and push in the piston pin with your
thumb.
LH Piston
Front Mark
(1 Cavity)
Outside Mark
RH Piston
Front Mark
(2 Cavities)
Outside Mark
A134389E01
(f)
6.
A004860
Using a screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the
other side of the piston pin hole.
INSTALL PISTON RING SET
(a) Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
EM–152
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 piston
rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code mark:
No. 1
No. 1
None
No. 2
2R
No. 2
Code Mark 2R
A134390E01
LH Piston
(c) Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not align the ring ends.
No. 2 Piston Ring
Lower
Side Rail
45°
60°
Expander
EM
Front Mark
(1 Cavity)
45°
60°
RH Piston
Lower
Side Rail
60°
Upper Side Rail
No. 1 Piston Ring
No. 2 Piston Ring
45°
Expander
Front Mark
(2 Cavities)
60°
Upper Side Rail
45°
No. 1 Piston Ring
A054735E01
EM06484
7.
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD BEARING
(a) Align the bearing claw with the groove of the
connecting rod or connecting cap.
(b) Install the bearings in the connecting rod and
connecting rod cap.
8.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT BEARING
HINT:
• Main bearings come in widths of 19.5 mm (0.768 in.)
and 22.5 mm (0.886 in.). Install the 22.5 mm (0.886
in.) bearings in the No. 1 and No. 5 cylinder block
journal positions with the crankshaft bearing cap.
Install the 19.5 mm (0.768 in.) bearings in the other
positions.
• Upper bearings have an oil groove and oil holes;
lower bearings do not.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–153
(a) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
cylinder block, and push in the 5 upper bearings.
A004216
(b) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
crankshaft bearing cap, and push in the 5 lower
bearings.
HINT:
A number is marked on each bearing cap to indicate
the installation position.
Mark 1, 2,
3, 4, or 5
EM
A004214E02
9.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER SET
(a) Install the 2 thrust washers under the No. 3 journal
position of the cylinder block with the oil grooves
facing outward.
A066654
(b) Install the 2 thrust washers on the No. 3 bearing cap
with the grooves facing outward.
10. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY SET CRANKSHAFT
KEY
A004217
11. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT
(a) Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(b) Install the 5 crankshaft bearing caps in their proper
locations.
HINT:
Place the bearing caps level and let them return to
their original positions by their own weight.
NOTICE:
Do not install the bearing cap by tapping it.
A005091
EM–154
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
4
2
8
6
7
10
3
1
5
9
A005095E02
EM
(c) Install the crankshaft bearing cap bolts.
HINT:
• The bearing cap bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps.
• If any one of the bearing cap bolts is broken or
deformed, replace it.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads
and under the heads of the crankshaft bearing
cap bolts.
(2) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 crankshaft
bearing cap bolts in several steps, in the order
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 in.*lbf)
If any one of the bearing cap bolts does not
meet the torque specification, replace the
bearing cap bolt.
(3) Mark the front of the crankshaft bearing cap
bolts with paint.
(4) Retighten the crankshaft bearing cap bolts by
90° in the order shown.
(5) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90°
angle to the front.
(6) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
90°
90°
Front
Painted
Mark
A005094E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–155
12. INSTALL PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
(a) Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly
numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies
into each cylinder with the front mark of the piston
facing forward.
NOTICE:
The shape of the piston varies for the LH and RH
banks. The LH piston is marked with 1 cavity
and "2", the RH piston with 2 cavities and "2".
Front
LH Piston
Front Mark
(1 Cavity)
EM
Front
Front Mark
(2 Cavities)
RH Piston
A134391E01
(b) Place the connecting rod cap on the connecting rod.
(1) Match the numbered connecting rod cap with
the connecting rod.
(2) Align the pin groove of the connecting rod cap
with the pins of the connecting rod, and install
the connecting rod cap.
A005106
EM–156
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(3) Check that the outside mark of the connecting
rod cap is facing in the correct direction.
LH Bank:
Front
Outside Mark (Protrusion)
RH Bank:
Front
EM
Outside Mark (Protrusion)
A005174E02
A005101
90°
(c) Install the connecting rod cap bolts.
HINT:
• The connecting rod cap bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps.
• If any one of the connecting rod cap bolts is
broken or deformed, replace it.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads
and under the heads of the connecting rod cap
bolts.
(2) Install and alternately tighten the 2 connecting
rod cap bolts in several steps.
Torque: 25 N*m (250 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
If any one of the connecting rod cap bolts does
not meet the torque specification, replace the
connecting rod cap bolts.
(3) Mark the front of the connecting cap bolt with
paint.
(4) Retighten the cap bolts 90° as shown in the
illustration.
(5) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90°
angle to the front.
(d) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
90°
Front
Painted
Mark
A005099E02
EM–157
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
13. INSTALL NO. 1 TIGHT PLUG
(a) Apply adhesive to the tight plug.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or equivalent
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new tight plug as
shown in the illustration.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00300), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Front Side
14. INSTALL CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP SETTING RING
PIN
(a) Install the camshaft bearing cap setting ring pin.
EM
Rear Side
SST
A134385E01
Cylinder Head Cover Side
A
A
A
A
Front Side of LH Bank
A
A
A
Front Side of RH Bank
C
C
A
B
A
A
A
A
B
A
A
A
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
A
3 mm
(0.12 in.)
8 mm
(0.31 in.)
7 mm
(0.28 in.)
A: Ring Pin
B
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
0.5 mm
(0.020 in.)
8 mm
(0.31 in.)
B: Ring Pin
C: Ball
A053859E01
EM–158
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
15. INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Install the stud bolt.
Intake Manifold Side
A
A
C
C
C
C
Exhaust Manifold Side
B
B
B
B
B
EM
A: Stud Bolt (Thread
diameter: 8 mm)
B: Stud Bolt (Thread
diameter: 10 mm)
24.5 mm
(0.965 in.)
26 mm
(1.02 in.)
14 mm
(0.55 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
B
C: Stud Bolt (Thread
diameter: 8 mm)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
28 mm
(1.10 in.)
B
B
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
28 mm
(1.10 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
A053860E01
Torque: For A and C
9.0 N*m (90 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
For B
15. N*m (150 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
Exhaust
Black
Gray
Intake
Gray
Brown
A053861E03
16. INSTALL VALVE STEM OIL SEAL
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new oil seal.
NOTICE:
Pay close attention when installing the intake
and exhaust oil seals. For example, installing
the intake oil seal into the exhaust or installing
the exhaust oil seal to the intake can cause
installation problems later.
HINT:
The intake valve oil seal is gray/brown and the
exhaust valve oil seal is black/gray.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–159
(b) Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201-41020
NOTICE:
Failure to use SST will cause the seal to be
damaged or improperly seated.
SST
A053857E02
17. INSTALL VALVE
(a) Install the following parts:
(1) Valve (1)
(2) Spring seat (2)
(3) Valve spring (3)
(4) Spring retainer (4)
(4)
(3)
(2)
(1)
EM
A005711E01
(b) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the
2 spring retainer locks around the valve stem.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
SST
A005712E01
(c) Using a plastic hammer and the valve stem (not in
use) tip wrapped with vinyl tape, lightly tap the valve
stem tip to assure proper fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not do damage the valve stem tip.
18. INSTALL VALVE LIFTER
(a) Install the valve lifter and shim.
(b) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
Vinyl tape
A054352E02
SST
Return
Claw
SST
Downward
A004108E01
19. INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBE GASKET
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new gasket until
its surface is flush with the upper edge of the
cylinder head cover.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00240, 09951-00440,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Apply a light coat of MP grease to the gasket lip.
(c) Return the 4 ventilation case claws to the original
positions.
EM–160
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
20. INSTALL CAMSHAFT SETTING OIL SEAL
(a) Insert a new oil seal into the camshaft timing tube
until it reaches the stopper.
NOTICE:
• Be careful of the installation direction.
• Do not turn over the oil seal lip.
Front
A054966E01
5 mm Hexagon
Wrench
SST
EM
A054965E03
21. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the timing tube knock pin with the knock pin
groove of the drive gear, and temporarily install the
drive gear with the 4 bolts.
(b) Using SST and a 5 mm hexagon wrench, uniformly
tighten the 4 bolts in several steps.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing tube.
(c) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A054967
(d) Align the camshaft knock pin with the knock pin
groove of the timing tube, and push the timing tube
by hand until it touches the bottom.
(e) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the bolt.
Torque: 78 N*m (795 kgf*cm, 58 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the seal washer and screw plug.
Torque: 15 N*m (152 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
10 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
A054962E02
[1]
[2]
Pin
[3]
Pin
A054971E01
22. INSTALL CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Install the gear spring [1], sub gear [2] and wave
washer [3].
HINT:
Attach the pins on the gears to the gear spring ends.
EM–161
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
A054970
(c) Mount the hexagonal portion of the camshaft in a
vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
EM
A054968
Sub Gear
SST
Main
Gear
Service Bolt
Turn
A054972E01
(d) Using SST, align the holes of the driven main gear
and sub gear by turning the sub gear clockwise, and
temporarily install a service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(e) Align the gear teeth of the driven main gear and sub
gear, and tighten the service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm (0.63 to 0.79 in.)
23. INSTALL OIL PUMP SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011)
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST
A054146E02
24. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer
edge.
SST 09223-56010
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST
A054148E02
EM–162
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
25. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the oil seal retainer and cylinder block.
(1) Using a razor blade and gasket scraper,
remove all the oil packing (FIPG) material from
the gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil seal retainer as shown
in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
(1) Use a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 to 4 mm
(0.12 to 0.16 in.) opening.
(2) Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
(3) Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
A
B
EM
Seal Width
3 to 4 mm
A
B
A004848E02
(c) Install a new O-ring to the cylinder block.
(d) Install the oil seal retainer with the 7 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
New O-Ring
A004855E02
EM–163
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
A
B
A
Seal Width
2 to 3 mm
B
B000960E03
26. INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the oil pump and cylinder block.
(1) Using a razor blade and gasket scraper,
remove all the old packing (FIPG) material from
the gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil pump as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
NOTICE:
Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface, especially around the oil passage.
(1) Use a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 to 3 mm
(0.08 to 0.12 in.) opening.
(2) Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
(3) Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
(c) Install a new O-ring to the cylinder block.
(d) Engage the spline teeth of the oil pump drive gear
with the large teeth of the crankshaft, and slide the
oil pump on the crankshaft.
New O-Ring
Engage
P021388E01
(e) Install the oil pump with a new stud bolt and the 7
bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts diagonally.
HINT:
• Use a 6mm hexagon wrench to tighten the
hexagon head bolt.
• The following chart is the reference of the oil
pump bolt length.
C
C C
6 mm
Hexagon
Wrench B
E
D
C
Bolt
A
B013038E04
Size of Bolt Head
Length
A
12 mm
50 mm (1.97 in.)
B
14 mm Stud Bolt
102.8 mm (4.047 in.)
C
12 mm
35 mm (1.38 in.)
D
14 mm
44 mm (1.73 in.)
E
6 mm Hexagon
28 mm (1.10 in.)
Torque: For bolts A, B, C and E
16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
EM
EM–164
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
For bolt D
31 N*m (311 kgf*cm, 23 ft.*lbf)
27. INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the 2
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Use bolts 12 mm (0.47 in.) in length.
28. INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Install the stud bolt.
A072708
8.5 mm (0.335 in.)
EM
24.5 mm
(0.965 in.)
8.5 mm (0.335 in.)
Stud Bolt (Thread diameter: 6mm)
A072716E01
Torque: 3.5 N*m (36 kgf*cm, 31 in.*lbf)
B
A
A
Seal Width
3 to 5 mm
B
A072709E01
29. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the No. 1 oil pan, cylinder block, oil pump and rear
oil seal retainer.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the No. 1 oil pan as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
• Use a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 to 5 mm
(0.12 to 0.20 in.) opening.
• Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
• Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(c) Temporarily install the oil pan with the 18 bolts and 2
nuts.
HINT:
The following chart is the reference for the oil pump
bolt length.
0.2 mm
B B
B
B
C C
A
A
D
A
D
A
B
B
B
B
EM–165
C C
A072710E01
Bolt
Size of Bolt Head
Length
A
10 mm
20 mm (0.79 in.)
B
12 mm
25 mm (0.98 in.)
C
12 mm
60 mm (2.36 in.)
D
10 mm
35 mm (1.38 in.)
(d) Set the oil pan as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the clearance between the rear
end of the oil pan and cylinder block is 0.2 mm
(0.008 in.) or less.
If the clearance is more than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.),
the oil pan will be stretched.
(e) Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts diagonally.
Torque: For bolts A and D
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
For bolts B, C and nut
28 N*m (286 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
30. INSTALL OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
(a) Install the baffle plate with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Use bolts 12 mm (0.47 in.) in length.
A072705
EM
EM–166
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
A
B
A
EM
Seal Width
3 to 5 mm
B
A072711E01
A054358
31. INSTALL NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any oil packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the No. 1 and No. 2 oil pans.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove
all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
• Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
• Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
NOTICE:
Do not use a solvent which will affect the
painted surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the No. 2 oil pan as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
• Use a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 to 5 mm
(0.12 to 0.20 in.) opening.
• Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
• Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
(c) Install the No. 2 oil pan with the 17 bolts and 2 nuts.
Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in several steps.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Use bolts 14 mm (0.55 in.) in length.
32. INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and water pump with the 5
bolts, 2 stud bolts and nut. Uniformly tighten the
bolts, stud bolts and nut in several steps.
Torque: Bolt
21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
Stud bolt and nut
18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use bolts 35 mm (1.38 in.) in length.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–167
33. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Place 2 new cylinder head gaskets in position on
the cylinder block.
HINT:
A mark is placed on the rear side of the cylinder
head gasket to distinguish the LH and RH banks, a
"2R" mark for the RH bank and a "2L" mark for the
LH bank.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the 2 cylinder heads in position on the
cylinder head gaskets.
RH Cylinder Head
LH Cylinder Head
EM
A134378E01
RH Cylinder Head
10
4
2
5
7
1
3
9
Front
1
6
8
A
6
8
LH Cylinder Head
9
3
A
7
5
2
4
10
A072703E02
(c) Install the cylinder head bolts.
HINT:
• The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2
progressive steps (Procedures "A" and "B").
• If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed,
replace it.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads
and under the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(2) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head
bolt.
(3) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 cylinder
head bolts on one side of the cylinder head in
several steps in the order shown in the
illustration, then do the other side in the same
way (Procedure "A").
Torque: 40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not
meet the torque specification, replace the
cylinder head bolt.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the plate washer for the
cylinder head bolt into portion A of the
cylinder head. If dropped into portion A, the
plate washer will pass through the cylinder
head and cylinder block into the oil pan.
EM–168
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(4) Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head
with paint.
(5) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90° in the
numerical order shown (Procedure "B").
(6) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by an
additional 90°.
(7) Check that the painted mark is now at a 180°
angle to front.
90°
180°
Painted Mark
A011159E01
EM
Dot
Set Key
Turn
A054460E01
34. INSTALL CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small,
the camshaft must be kept level while it is being
installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion
of the cylinder head which receives the shaft thrust
may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to
seize or break. To avoid this, the following steps
should be carried out.
(a) Set the crankshaft position.
(1) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft, and set the set key of the
crankshaft at the position of 90°
counterclockwise from the timing mark (dot) of
the oil pump body.
CAUTION:
Having the crankshaft at a wrong angle can
cause the piston head and valve head to
come into contact with each other when
installing the camshaft, causing damage. So
always set the crankshaft at the correct
angle.
(b) Install the camshafts of the RH bank.
(1) Apply engine oil to the thrust portions of the
intake and exhaust camshafts.
(2) Align the timing marks (1-dot mark) of the
camshaft drive and driven main gears, and
place the 2 camshafts.
(3) Set the timing marks (1-dot mark) of the
camshaft drive and driven main gears at
approx. 10° angle.
Apporx. 10°
A054974E01
Seal Packing
RH Bank
A054975E02
(4) Apply seal packing to the camshaft housing
plug.
• Remove the old packing (FIPG) material.
• Apply seal packing to the housing plug.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–169
(5) Install the camshaft housing plug and oil control
valve filter to the cylinder head as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
A054976
Seal Width
1.5 to 2.0 mm
Seal Packing
Groove
A072712E01
(6) Apply seal packing to the front bearing cap.
• Remove any old packing (FIPG) material
and be careful not to drop any oil on the
contact surfaces of the bearing cap and
cylinder head.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper,
remove all the old packing (FIPG) material
from the gasket surfaces and groove.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove
all the loose material.
Using a non-residue solvent, clean both
sealing surfaces.
• Apply seal packing to the bearing cap as
shown in the illustration.
Use a nozzle that has been cut to 1.5 to 2.0
mm (0.059 to 0.079 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes
of application. Otherwise the material must
be removed and reapplied.
Immediately remove the nozzle from the
tube and reinstall the cap.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
NOTICE:
Do not apply seal packing to the front
bearing cap grooves.
(7) Install the front bearing cap.
HINT:
The thrust position of the camshaft will be
determined after installing the front bearing
cap.
(8) Install the other bearing caps in the order
shown with the arrow mark facing forward.
A054977
EM
EM–170
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(9) Push in the camshaft setting oil seal.
Push
A054978E01
C
E
D
E
A
B
EM
E
E
D
C
A004469E01
RH Bank
21
8
5
9
17
10
18
3
4
11
15
7
13
1
12
6
14
2
19
20
22
16
(10) Install new seal washers to the bearing cap
bolts (A and B).
(11) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads
and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts
(D and E).
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil under the heads of
the bearing cap bolts (A), (B) and (C).
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
94 mm (3.70 in.) for A with seal washer
72 mm (2.83 in.) for B with seal washer
25 mm (0.98 in.) for C
55 mm (2.17 in.) for D
40 mm (1.57 in.) for E
(12) Install the oil feed pipe and the 22 bearing cap
bolts as shown in the illustration.
(13) Uniformly tighten the 22 bearing cap bolts in
several steps, in the order shown in the
illustration.
Torque: For bolt C
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
For others
16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
A054151E05
(14) Bring the service bolt installed in the driven
sub-gear upward by turning the hexagonal
portion of the camshaft with a wrench.
(15) Remove the service bolt.
Service Bolt
A054149E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–171
(c) Install the camshafts of the LH bank.
(1) Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the
camshafts.
(2) Align the timing marks (2-dot marks) of the
camshaft drive and driven main gears, and
place the 2 camshafts.
A054979
Seal Packing
LH Bank
(3) Apply seal packing to the camshaft housing
plug.
• Remove the old packing (FIPG) material.
• Apply seal packing to the housing plug.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
EM
A054975E03
(4) Install the camshaft housing plug and oil control
valve filter to the cylinder head as shown in the
illustration.
CAUTION:
Be careful of the installation direction.
B002649
Seal Packing
Seal Width
1.5 to 2.0 mm
Groove
A072713E01
(5) Apply seal packing to the front bearing cap.
• Remove any old packing (FIPG) material
and be careful not to drop any oil on the
contact surfaces of the bearing cap and
cylinder head.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper,
remove all the old packing (FIPG) material
from the gasket surfaces and groove.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove
all the loose material.
Using a non-residue solvent, clean both
sealing surfaces.
• Apply seal packing to the bearing cap as
shown in the illustration.
Use a nozzle that has been cut to 1.5 to 2.0
mm (0.059 to 0.079 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes
of application. Otherwise the material must
be removed and reapplied.
Immediately remove the nozzle from the
tube and reinstall the cap.
EM–172
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
NOTICE:
Do not apply seal packing to the front
bearing cap grooves.
(6) Install the front bearing cap.
HINT:
The thrust position of the camshaft will be
determined after installing the front bearing
cap.
(7) Install the other bearing cap in the order shown
with the arrow mark facing forward.
A054981
(8) Push in the camshaft setting oil seal.
EM
Push
A054982E01
A
C
A
E
B
B
C
D
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
D
E
E
A054154E03
(9) Install a new seal washer to the bearing cap
bolts (A and B).
(10) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads
and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts
(D and E).
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil under the heads of
the bearing cap bolts (A), (B) and (C).
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
94 mm (3.70 in.) for A with seal washer
72 mm (2.83 in.) for B with seal washer
25 mm (0.98 in.) for C
55 mm (2.17 in.) for D
40 mm (1.57 in.) for E
(11) Install the oil feed pipe and the 22 bearing cap
bolts as shown in the illustration.
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
1
21
LH Bank
2
10
3
4
6
14
9
5
17
13
7
22
12
19
18
8
20
11
15
16
EM–173
(12) Uniformly tighten the 22 bearing cap bolts in
several steps, in the order shown in the
illustration.
Torque: For bolt C
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
For others
16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
A054154E05
(13) Bring the service bolt installed in the driven
sub-gear upward by turning the hexagonal
portion of the camshaft with a wrench.
(14) Remove the service bolt.
35. INSTALL REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Install the rear timing belt plate with the bolt and
stud bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
Service Bolt
A054152E01
36. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE RH
(a) Install the rear timing belt plate with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
37. INSTALL REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Install the rear timing belt plate with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
38. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR TIMING BELT PLATE LH
(a) Install the rear timing belt plate with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
Inward
SST
39. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Fit the timing pulley set key to the key groove of the
pulley.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the timing pulley
with the flange side facing inward.
SST 09223-46011
A004446E01
40. INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the idler with the bolt.
Torque: 35 N*m (352 kgf*cm, 25 ft.*lbf)
(b) Check that the idler moves smoothly.
A072699
EM
EM–174
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Adhesive
Plate Washer
10 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
41. INSTALL NO. 1 TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the pivot bolt.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond
1344 or equivalent
(b) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the plate
washer and idler with the pivot bolt.
Torque: 35 N*m (352 kgf*cm, 25 ft.*lbf)
(c) Check that the idler bracket moves smoothly.
A054472E02
42. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(a) Align the camshaft timing tube knock pin with the
knock pin groove of the timing pulley.
(b) Attach the timing pulley to the camshaft timing tube.
Face the timing pulley's "R" and "L" marks forward.
(c) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft.
(d) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, install the 8 bolts.
Torque: 8.1 N*m (83 kgf*cm, 72 in.*lbf)
RH Bank:
EM
43. INSTALL TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
The engine should be cold.
LH Bank:
A134379E01
1 Tooth
1/2 Teeth
A139504E01
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Turn the hexagonal portion of the camshaft to
align the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys and timing belt plates.
HINT:
By turning the camshaft timing pulleys
clockwise as follows, installation of the timing
pulleys will be easy:
1/2 teeth turn for the left bank camshaft timing
pulley
1 tooth turn for the right bank camshaft timing
pulley
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–175
(2) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, turn the
crankshaft to align the timing marks of the
crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
Turn
A054465E01
A054463
1.27 mm Hexagon Wrench
A054983E02
(b) Install the timing belt.
(1) Remove any oil or water on each pulley. Keep
them clean after removal.
NOTICE:
Only wipe the pulleys; do not use any
cleansing agent.
(2) Face the front mark (arrow) on the timing belt
forward.
(3) Connect the timing belt to the crankshaft timing
pulley.
• Align the installation mark on the timing belt
with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing
pulley.
(4) Connect the No. 2 timing belt to the idler.
(5) Connect the timing belt to the camshaft timing
pulley LH.
• Align the installation mark on the timing belt
with the timing mark of the camshaft timing
pulley.
(6) Connect the timing belt to the water pump
pulley.
(7) Connect the timing belt to the camshaft timing
pulley (RH bank).
• Align the installation mark on the timing belt
with the timing mark of the camshaft timing
pulley.
(8) Connect the No. 1 timing belt to the idler.
(c) Set the belt tensioner.
(1) Using a press, slowly press in the push rod
using 981 to 9,807 N (100 to 1,000 kgf, 220 to
2,205 lbf) of pressure.
(2) Align the holes of the push rod and housing,
pass a 1.27 mm hexagon wrench through the
holes to keep the setting position of the push
rod.
(3) Release the press.
(4) Install the dust boot to the belt tensioner.
EM
EM–176
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(d) Install the belt tensioner.
(1) Temporarily install the belt tensioner with the 2
bolts.
(2) Alternately tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 26 N*m (270 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
(3) Using pliers, remove the 1.27 mm hexagon
wrench from the belt tensioner.
1.27 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
A054462E02
(e) Check the valve timing.
(1) Using the crankshaft damper bolt, slowly turn
the crankshaft pulley 2 revolutions from the
TDC to TDC.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft pulley
clockwise.
EM
Turn
A054456E01
(2) Check that each pulley aligns with the timing
marks as shown in the illustration.
If the timing marks are not aligned, remove the
timing belt and reinstall it.
A054458
44. INSTALL NO. 1 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
PLATE
(a) Install the sensor plate as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Take care not to install it in a wrong direction.
Front
A053994E01
45. INSTALL TIMING GEAR COVER SPACER
(a) Install the gasket to the cover spacer.
(b) Install the cover spacer.
A072695E01
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–177
46. INSTALL NO. 1 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
A072694
47. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT DAMPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the
crankshaft damper.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the crankshaft
damper.
SST 09223-46011
SST
EM
A054471E02
(c) Using SST, install the damper bolt.
SST 09213-70011 (90105-08076), 09330-00021
Torque: 245 N*m (2,498 kgf*cm, 181 ft.*lbf)
48. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page EM-8)
49. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page EM-8)
SST
A054469E02
[A]
[B]
[A]
A134365E04
50. INSTALL FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the idler pulley with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: For 12 mm head
16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
For 14 mm head
32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
106 mm (4.17 in.) for 12 mm head [A]
114 mm (4.49 in.) for 14 mm head [B]
51. INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the belt tensioner with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use a bolt 106 mm (4.17 in.) in length.
A072692
EM–178
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
52. INSTALL NO. 2 TIMING BELT COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the timing belt cover and fit the claws and
pins into each part.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use bolts 106 mm (4.17 in.) in length.
A054467
53. INSTALL NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the idler pulley and cover plate with the bolt.
Torque: 39 N*m (398 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
EM
A072691
54. INSTALL SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the semicircular plug grooves.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
Seal Packing
A054984E02
(c) Install the 4 semicircular plugs to the cylinder heads
as shown in the illustration.
RH Bank:
LH Bank:
A054985E02
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–179
55. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder heads as shown
in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
(c) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(d) Install the seal washer to the bolt.
(e) Install the cylinder head cover with the 9 bolts.
Uniformly tighten the bolts in several steps.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
RH Bank:
LH Bank:
EM
Seal Packing
:
A054067E02
56. INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP HOUSING
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil filler cap housing
with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
57. INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
58. INSTALL SPARK PLUG
Torque: 18 N*m (178 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
A072688
59. INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply seal packing to 2 or 3 threads.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three
Bond 1282B or equivalent
Seal Packing
P012477E01
(b) Install the 2 drain cocks.
Torque: 49 N*m (500 kgf*cm, 36 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
After tightening to the specified torque, rotate the
drain union clockwise until its drain port is facing
forward.
A004856
EM–180
2UZ-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
60. INSTALL ENGINE HANGERS
(a) Install the 2 engine hangers with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (380 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
A072687
EM
FU–10
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
HINT:
(See page FU-1)
2.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 cap nuts and throttle body cover subassembly.
3.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hoses (for the P/S idle-up
and fuel pressure regulator) and ventilation hose.
(b) Remove the air cleaner hose assembly.
4.
REMOVE NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 union bolts and 4 gaskets.
(b) Remove the bolts and fuel pipe sub-assembly.
5.
SEPARATE NO. 3 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the No. 2 fuel pipe clamp.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and disconnect the fuel return
pipe sub-assembly from the fuel pressure regulator.
HINT:
Move it aside to secure more work space.
6.
DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE
(a) Remove the pulsation damper and 2 gaskets.
(b) Disconnect the No. 1 fuel hose.
7.
SEPARATE NO. 1 VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolts and separate the vacuum
switching valve assembly from the intake manifold.
8.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the 8 fuel injector connectors.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and disconnect the engine wire.
9.
REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, and then the fuel delivery pipe
by holding both ends and pulling it straight upward.
FU
A133776
A066659
10. REMOVE NO. 2 FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, and then the No.2 fuel delivery
pipe by holding both ends and pulling it straight
upward.
11. REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the injector from the delivery pipe.
NOTICE:
Do not apply any force to the injector in the
horizontal direction because the O-ring might be
stuck.
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
FU–11
(b) Remove the O-ring, grommet and insulator from the
injector.
FU
FU–12
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
INSPECTION
1.
Pressure Regulator
SST
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the injector resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
13.4 to 14.2 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
injector.
(b) Inspect the injector.
CAUTION:
Avoid any sparks or flame during the test.
Fuel Tube
Connector
SST
Injector
SST
A067125E01
FU
(1) Obtain a new fuel main hose (part No. 2327150190) and take the fuel tube connector out of
the hose.
Fuel Tube Connector
A050710E14
Fuel Tube Connector
Fuel Pipe
SST (Hose)
B012947E09
Pressure
Regulator
SST (Hose)
SST (Union)
O-Ring
Fuel Return Hose
A133773E01
(2) Install the fuel tube connector to SST (hose),
then connect the tube connector and fuel pipe.
SST 09268-31011 (95336-08070)
CAUTION:
Observe the precautions when connecting
the fuel tube connector (quick type).
(3) Remove the pressure regulator from the
delivery pipe.
(4) Install the O-ring to the fuel inlet of the pressure
regulator.
(5) Connect the SST (hose) to the fuel inlet of the
pressure regulator with another SST (union)
and the 2 bolts.
SST 09268-31011 (95336-08070, 0926841091)
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(6) Connect the fuel return hose to the fuel outlet of
the pressure regulator.
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
(7) Install the O-ring to the injector.
(8) Connect SSTs (union and hose) to the injector,
and hold the injector and union with another
SST (clamp).
SST 09268-31011 (09268-41110, 0926841300, 95336-08070)
(9) Put the injector into a graduated cylinder.
CAUTION:
Install a suitable vinyl tube onto the injector
to prevent gasoline from splashing out.
(10) Operate the fuel pump (See page FU-5).
SST (Hose)
SST (Union)
O-Ring
SST (Clamp)
Vinyl Tube
FU–13
B000884E02
(11) Connect SST (wire) to the injector and battery
for 15 seconds, and measure the injection
volume with the graduated cylinder. Test each
injector 2 or 3 times.
SST 09842-30070
Volume:
56 to 69 cm3 (3.4 to 4.2 cu in.) per 15
seconds
Difference between each injector:
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
If the injection volume is not as specified,
replace the injector.
SST
(Wire)
Connect
B000883E01
(c) Check for leakage.
(1) In the condition above, disconnect the tester
probes of the SST (wire) from the battery and
check for fuel leakage from the injector.
SST 09842-30070
Fuel drop:
1 drop or less per 12 minutes
A001293
INSTALLATION
New Insulator
1.
INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new grommet and insulator to the injector.
(b) Check that there is no foreign object or damage to
the groove of the O-ring of the injector. Apply
gasoline to a new O-ring, and install it to the injector.
(c) Install the injector to the delivery pipe while turning
the injector in both ways.
(d) Check that the injector can turn smoothly.
NOTICE:
When the injector cannot turn smoothly, the Oring might be caught in something. In that case,
replace the O-ring with a new one.
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the injector with the delivery pipe to the intake
manifold.
(b) Turn the injector in both ways by approximately 45
degrees.
New Grommet
New O-Ring
A066663E01
FU
FU–14
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
(c) Inserting a spacer between the delivery pipe and the
intake manifold, install the delivery pipe with the
injector with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
New
Gasket
FU
3.
INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the injector with the delivery pipe to the intake
manifold.
(b) Turn the injector in both ways by approximately 45
degrees.
(c) Inserting a spacer between the delivery pipe and the
intake manifold, install the delivery pipe with the
injector with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FUEL HOSE
(a) Using 2 new gaskets, install the fuel main hose with
the fuel pressure pulsation damper.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
ASSEMBLY
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL NO. 3 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the fuel pipe sub-assembly with the bolts.
(b) Using 4 new gaskets, install the No. 1 fuel pipe subassembly with the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
9.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE (See page FU-5)
A066659E02
10. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
FU–17
(d) Remove the O-ring from the fuel pump.
A133793
5.
REMOVE NO. 2 FUEL SUCTION PLATE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 E-rings from the
No. 2 suction plate.
(b) Remove the No. 2 suction plate and 2 springs from
the No. 1 fuel suction plate.
A133794
Ohmmeter
INSPECTION
1.
A133774E01
2
1
Battery
A133775E01
INSPECT FUEL PUMP
(a) Inspect the fuel pump resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between terminals 1 and 2.
Standard resistance::
0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
fuel pump.
(b) Inspect fuel pump operation.
(1) Connect the lead wire to the fuel pump.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 1 of the connector, and the negative
(-) lead to terminal 2. Check that the fuel pump
operates.
NOTICE:
• These tests must be done quickly (within
10 seconds) to prevent the coil from
burning out.
• Keep the fuel pump as far away from the
battery as possible.
• Always switch on the battery side.
If the fuel pump dose not operate, replace the
fuel pump and/or lead wire.
(3) Disconnect the lead wire from the fuel pump.
FU
FU–18
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO. 2 FUEL SUCTION PLATE
(a) Install the 2 springs and No. 2 suction plate to the
No. 1 suction plate.
(b) Using needle-nose pliers, install 2 new E-rings to
the No. 2 suction plate.
2.
INSTALL FUEL PUMP
(a) Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new
O-ring, and install it to the fuel pump.
A133794
A133793
FU
(b) Connect the fuel pump harness connector to the
fuel pump.
A133792
(c) Install the suction filter to the fuel pump.
(d) Install the fuel pump with the suction filter to the fuel
filter.
A133791
3.
A133795
INSTALL FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH FILTER
(a) Install the fuel filter to the fuel sub-tank.
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
4.
FU–19
INSTALL FUEL SUB-TANK
(a) Engage the 3 claws to install the No. 2 fuel suction
plate the fuel sub-tank.
A133789
(b) Connect the 2 tubes to the tube clamps.
A133788
(c) Connect the suction filter hose to the fuel sub-tank.
A133787
(d) Connect the fuel pump harness connector to the No.
1 fuel suction plate.
A133786
5.
Slide
A133796E01
INSTALL FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the fuel sender gage to the fuel suction
support.
FU
FU–20
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
(b) Connect the sender gage connector to the No. 1
fuel suction plate.
A133784
FU
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
FU–1
FUEL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
C/OPN Relay
A067118E01
3.
PRECAUTION
(a) Before working on the fuel system, disconnect the
negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
(b) Do not smoke or work near fire when working on the
fuel system.
(c) Keep gasoline away from rubber or leather parts.
WORK FOR PREVENT GASOLINE FROM SPILLING
OUT
CAUTION:
• Do not disconnect any part of the fuel system
until you have discharged the fuel system
pressure.
• Even after discharging the fuel pressure, place a
shop rag or piece of cloth over fittings to prevent
fuel splashing on yourself or in the engine
compartment when separating the fittings.
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the engine
room relay block.
(b) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch OFF.
HINT:
There is a case that DTC P0171 (system too lean) is
output.
(c) Check that the engine does not start.
(d) Remove the fuel tank cap, and let the air out of the
fuel tank.
(e) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(f) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
FUEL SYSTEM
(a) When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a
large amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe
the following procedures:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump tube (See page FU23).
(2) Drain the fuel remained inside the fuel pump
tube.
(3) Do not damage the disconnected pipe and
connector, and prevent intrusion of foreign
objects by covering them with a plastic bag.
(4) Place a container under the connection.
B000679
FU
FU–2
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
(b) When connecting the union bolt (fuel pressure
pulsation damper) on the high pressure pipe union,
observe the following procedures:
(1) Always use new gaskets.
(2) Tighten the union bolt by hand.
New Gasket
A133772E01
Fulcrum Length: 30 cm
SST
(3) Using SST, tighten the union bolt to the specified
torque.
SST 09612-24014 (09617-24011)
Torque: for use with SST
33 N*m (340 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30
cm (11.81 in.).
A067124E01
FU
(c) Observe the following precautions when removing
and installing the injectors:
(1) Never reuse the O-ring.
(2) When placing a new O-ring on the injector, do
not damage the O-ring.
(3) Coat the new O-ring with spindle oil or gasoline
before installing. Do not use engine oil, gear oil
or brake fluid.
CORRECT
O-Ring
WRONG
Delivery Pipe
B002714E04
O-Ring
Delivery Pipe
Grommet
Injector
Lower
Intake
Manifold
(d) Install the injector to the delivery pipe and lower
intake manifold, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Before installing the injector, apply spindle oil or
gasoline where the delivery pipe or intake
manifold contacts the O-ring of the injector.
Insulator
B004939E02
(e) Observe the following precautions when
disconnecting the fuel tube connector (Quick type
A):
(1) Remove the fuel pipe clamp No. 1.
(2) Check that there is no dirt on the pipe and
around the connector before disconnecting
them. Clean them if necessary.
(3) Disconnect them by hand.
Quick
Type A
Fuel Pipe
Clamp No. 1
A060083E19
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
(4) When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
pinch the fuel pipe with your fingers and push
the fuel tube connector to the fuel pipe by
pressing the release buttons, then pull the
connector out of the pipe.
(5) Check that there is no dirt or other foreign
objects on the seal surface of the disconnected
pipe. Clean it away if necessary.
(6) Do not damage the disconnected pipe and
connector, and prevent intrusion of foreign
objects by covering them with a plastic bag.
Quick Type A
Push
Push
Pull
B016533E03
(f)
Quick Type A
Push
FU–3
Observe the following precautions when connecting
the fuel tube connector (Quick Type A):
(1) Check that there is no damage or foreign objects
in the connected part of the pipe.
(2) Match the axis of the connector with the axis of
the pipe, and push into the connector until the
connector makes a "click" sound. In case that
the connection is tight, apply a small amount of
fresh engine oil to the tip of the pipe.
B016534E03
(3) After finishing the connection, check if the pipe
and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
(4) Check for fuel leaks.
Quick Type A
Pull
B016535E03
Quick Type B
Pull
Push
B002045E01
(g) Observe the following precautions when
disconnecting the fuel tube connector (Quick type
B):
(1) Check if there is any dirt on the pipe and around
the connector before disconnecting them. Clean
the dirt away if necessary.
(2) Disconnect them by hand.
(3) When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
push and pull the connector. Disconnect and pull
it out. Do not use any tool at this time.
(4) Check if there is any dirt or other foreign objects
on the seal surface of the disconnected pipe.
Clean it away if necessary.
(5) Do not damage the disconnected pipe and
connector, and prevent intrusion of foreign
objects by covering them with a plastic bag.
FU
FU–4
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
(h) Observe the following precautions when connecting
the fuel tube connector (Quick type B):
(1) Match the axis of the connector with the axis of
the pipe, and push in the connector until the
connector makes a "click" sound. In case that
the connection is tight, apply a small amount of
new engine oil to the tip of the pipe.
Quick Type B
Push
B002046E01
(2) After finishing the connection, check if the pipe
and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
(3) Check for fuel leaks.
Quick Type B
Pull
B002077E01
FU
(i)
Quick Type C
Fuel Hose Connector Cover
Observe the following precautions when
disconnecting the fuel tube connector (Quick type
C):
(1) Pull the fuel hose connector cover up to release
the lock.
(2) Check that there is no dirt in the pipe and around
the connector before disconnecting them. Clean
the dirt away if necessary.
(3) Be sure to disconnect them by hand.
G038120E01
(4) When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
pinch the fuel pipe between the hands, and push
and pull the connector. Disconnect and pull it
out. Do not use any tool at this time.
(5) Check if there is any dirt or other foreign objects
on the seal surface of the disconnected pipe.
Clean it away if necessary.
(6) Do not damage the disconnected pipe and
connector, and prevent intrusion of foreign
objects by covering them with a plastic bag.
Quick Type C
Push
Push
Pull
B016533E05
(j)
Quick Type C
Push
B016534E05
Observe the following precautions when connecting
the fuel tube connector (Quick Type C):
(1) Check that there is no damage or foreign objects
in the connected part of the pipe.
(2) Match the axis of the connector with the axis of
the pipe, and push into the connector until the
connector makes a "click" sound. In case that
the connection is tight, apply a small amount of
fresh engine oil to the tip of the pipe.
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
FU–5
(3) After finishing the connection, check if the pipe
and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
Quick Type C
Pull
B016535E05
Quick Type C
Fuel Hose Connector Cover
G038121E01
4.
(4) Lock the fuel hose connector cover.
HINT:
If the fuel tube is not completely connected, the
half connection prevention connector prevents
the fuel hose connector cover from being locked.
(5) Check for fuel leaks.
(k) Observe the following precautions when handling a
nylon tube:
CAUTION:
• Do not twist the connection part of the nylon
tube and the quick connector by force when
connecting them.
• Do not twist the nylon tube.
• Do not remove the EPDM protector on the
outside of the nylon tube.
• Do not close the piping with the nylon tube by
bending it.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK
(a) Check that there are no fuel leaks anywhere on the
fuel system after doing maintenance (See page FU5).
FU
FU–6
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION AND FUEL LEAK
(a) When using the intelligent tester
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and intelligent
tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(3) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the
intelligent tester.
(4) Please refer to the intelligent tester operator's
manual for further details.
(b) When not using the intelligent tester
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay.
(2) Using a service wire, connect terminals FP and
+B of the relay block.
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal
connecting position to avoid a malfunction.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check that the
fuel pump operates.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing
maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
FU
FP +B
A067117E01
(d) Check that the pulsation damper screw rises up
when the fuel pump operates.
If operation is not as specified, check the following
parts:
• Fusible link
• Fuses
• EFI main relay
• Fuel pump
• ECM
• Wiring connections
(e) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the intelligent tester from the DLC3.
Screw
UP
Pulsation
Damper
A067121E01
2.
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Remove the front fuel pipe from the LH delivery pipe
(See page FU-10).
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
SST (Adaptor)
SST (Union)
SST
(Gauge)
Gasket
Front Fuel Pipe
A067122E01
FU–7
(d) Install the front fuel pipe and SST (pressure gauge)
to the delivery pipe with the 3 gaskets and another
SST (adaptor).
SST 09268-45014 (09268-41200, 09268-41190,
90405-06167, 09268-41210, 90467-11009)
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(e) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(f) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the
battery.
(g) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (See step
1 in check fuel pump operation).
(h) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
265 to 304 kPa (2.7 to 3.1 kgf/cm2, 38 to 44 psi)
If pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure
regulator.
If pressure is low, check the following parts:
• Fuel hoses and connections
• Fuel pump
• Fuel filter
• Fuel pressure regulator
(i) Disconnect the intelligent tester from the DLC3.
(j) Start the engine.
(k) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
265 to 304 kPa (2.7 to 3.1 kgf/cm2, 38 to 44 psi)
(l) Stop the engine.
(m) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified
for 5 minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure:
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump,
pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(n) After checking the fuel pressure, disconnect the
negative (-) terminal cable from the battery and
carefully remove the SST to prevent gasoline from
splashing.
SST 09268-45014 (09268-41200, 09268-41190,
90405-06167, 09268-41210, 90467-11009)
(o) Reinstall the front fuel pipe to the LH delivery pipe
(See page FU-13).
(p) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the
battery.
(q) Check for fuel leaks (See step 1 in check fuel pump
operation).
FU
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
FU–21
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE TUBE
ASSEMBLY (See page FU-27)
FU
FU–8
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
FUEL INJECTOR
2UZ-FE FUEL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
8.2 (84, 73 in.*lbf)
VSV FOR AIR INJECTION
SYSTEM
NO. 3 FUEL PIPE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FU
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
ASSEMBLY
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
O-RING
FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
39 (400, 29)
GASKET
39 (400, 29)
NO. 2 FUEL
PIPE CLAMP
GASKET
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
21 (214, 16)
GASKET
NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
O-RING
INSULATOR
NO. 2 FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
FUEL INJECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
DELIVERY PIPE
NO. 1 SPACER
GROMMET
Non-reusable part
A119782E01
FU–9
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
18 (185, 13)
NO. 1 VACUUM SWITCHING
VALVE ASSEMBLY
VACUUM HOSE
VENTILATION HOSE
IDLE UP NO. 2 HOSE
ENGINE WIRE
FU
AIR CLEANER HOSE
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119948E01
FU–14
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
FUEL PUMP
2UZ-FE FUEL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
FUEL SUCTION SUPPORT
NO. 1 FUEL SUCTION PLATE
WITH FUEL FILTER
FUEL PUMP HARNESS
FUEL FILTER
FU
O-RING
FUEL SENDER GAGE
ASSEMBLY
SPRING
NO. 2 FUEL SUCTION PLATE
E-RING
E-RING
SUCTION FILTER HOSE
FUEL PUMP
FUEL SUCTION FILTER
FUEL SUB-TANK
Non-reusable part
A119785E01
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
FU–15
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE
TUBE ASSEMBLY (See page FU-25)
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the sender gage connector from the No.
1 fuel suction plate.
A133784
(b) Unlock the fuel sender gage and remove it.
Unlock
FU
Slide
A133785E01
2.
REMOVE FUEL SUB-TANK
(a) Disconnect the fuel pump harness connector from
the No. 1 fuel suction plate.
A133786
(b) Disconnect the suction filter hose from the fuel subtank.
A133787
FU–16
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP
(c) Disconnect the 2 tubes from the tube clamps.
A133788
(d) Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in tape,
disengage the 3 claws to separate the No. 2 fuel
suction plate.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the No. 2 fuel suction plate or
fuel sub-tank.
(e) Disconnect the No. 1 fuel suction plate with the fuel
filter assembly from the fuel sub-tank.
A133789
FU
3.
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH FILTER
(a) Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in tape,
disengage the 2 claws to separate the fuel suction
support.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel filter assembly or fuel
suction support.
(b) Remove the fuel filter assembly with the fuel pump
from the fuel suction support.
4.
REMOVE FUEL PUMP
(a) Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in tape,
disengage the 5 claws to separate the suction filter.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel filter assembly or
suction filter.
(b) Remove the fuel suction filter with the fuel pump
from the fuel filter.
A133790
A133791
(c) Disconnect the fuel pump harness connector from
the fuel pump.
A133792
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL PUMP RESISTOR
Ohmmeter
FU–21
FUEL PUMP RESISTOR
INSPECTION
1.
A072544E01
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RESISTOR
(a) Inspect the fuel pump resistor resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
0.70 to 0.76 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
FU
FU–22
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FUEL TANK
2UZ-FE FUEL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
Retainer
FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE
CLIP
FUEL TANK RETURN TUBE
FUEL TANK BREATHER
TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
FU
FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP
& GAGE TUBE ASSEMBLY
FUEL TANK TO FILLER
PIPE HOSE
FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
PIN
PIN
CLIP
CLIP
FUEL TANK BAND
FUEL TANK BAND
40 (408, 30)
40 (408, 30)
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
NO. 1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FUEL HOSE PROTECTOR
20 (204, 15)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A151308E01
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FU–23
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
HINT:
(See page FU-1)
2.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Hold the rear No. 1 seat assembly LH.
(b) Hold the rear No. 1 seat assembly RH.
(c) Remove the rear floor carpet assembly.
(d) Remove the 3 screws and rear floor service hole
cover.
(e) Disconnect the connector.
3.
DISCONNECT FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank to filler pipe hose from the
fuel filler pipe.
4.
DRAIN FUEL
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Set a transmission jack to the fuel tank protector.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and the fuel tank protector.
6.
DISCONNECT FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL
TANK RETURN TUBE
(a) Pinch and turn the projections of the retainers in the
direction shown by the arrow to release the lock.
Pull out the 2 fuel tank tubes.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no dirt or mud around the
quick connector before this work. Clean the
connector if necessary.
• Do not use any tool in this work.
• Do not bend or twist the nylon tube by force.
• To protect the tube, cover it with a plastic bag
after checking.
• When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
turn the retainer carefully to release.
Disconnect the fuel tank tube.
A133777
A067088
Nylon Tube
Retainer
O-ring
Pipe
A139367E01
FU
FU–24
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
Nylon Tube
7.
DISCONNECT FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Pinch and turn the projection of the retainer in the
direction shown by the arrow to release the lock.
Pull out the fuel tank breather tube.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no dirt or mud around the
quick connector before this work. Clean the
connector if necessary.
• Do not use any tool in this work.
• Do not bend or twist the nylon tube by force.
• To protect the tube, cover it with a plastic bag
after checking.
• When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
turn the retainer carefully to release.
Disconnect the tube.
8.
DISCONNECT FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank breather tube from the fuel
tank.
(1) Push the connector deep inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
9.
REMOVE FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Set a transmission jack to the fuel tank.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 fuel tank bands and fuel tank.
Retainer
O-ring
Pipe
A139368E01
FU
Push
Pinch
A
Pinch
A
A067090E01
10. REMOVE FUEL TANK CUSHION
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
Nylon Tube
Fuel Tube Joint
O-ring
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Suction Plate
FU–25
11. REMOVE FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK
RETURN TUBE
(a) Remove the 2 clips, and pull out the 2 fuel tank
tubes.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no dirt or mud around the
quick connector before this work. Clean the
connector if necessary.
• Do not use any tool in this work.
• Do not bend or twist the nylon tube by force.
• After disconnecting, cover the fuel tube joint
with a plastic bag.
• When the fuel tube joint and fuel suction plate
are stuck, turn the fuel tank main tube
carefully to release and disconnect it.
Likewise, disconnect the fuel tank return
tube.
12. REMOVE FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE
TUBE ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
Protect a connector and tube joint with masking tape
or something in order to prevent sticking foreign
objects onto them, and clean dirt and foreign objects
from the fuel suction tube assembly before
removing it.
A139373E01
SST
Rib
A072554E01
(a) Using SST, loosen the retainer.
SST 09808-14020 (09808-01410, 09808-01430)
HINT:
A rib on the retainer can be fitted into the tip of SST.
(b) Remove the retainer.
(c) Remove the fuel suction with pump & gage tube
assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the sender
gage.
(d) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
FU
FU–26
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
13. REMOVE FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Pinch and turn the projection of the retainer in the
direction shown by the arrow to release the lock.
Pull out the fuel tank breather tube.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no dirt or mud around the
quick connector before this work. Clean the
connector if necessary.
• Do not use any tool in this work.
• Do not bend or twist the nylon tube by force.
• To protect the tube, cover it with a plastic bag
after checking.
• When the connector and the pipe are stuck,
turn the fuel tank breather tube carefully to
release. Disconnect the tube.
Nylon Tube
Retainer
14. REMOVE FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Remove the fuel tank to filler pipe hose from the fuel
tank.
FU
O-ring
Pipe
A139370E01
INSTALLATION
0 to 3 mm (0 to 0.12 in.)
1.
CONNECT FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Connect a new fuel tank to filler pipe hose to the fuel
tank.
HINT:
Make sure that the hose and tank are connected as
shown in the illustration.
2.
INSTALL FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Push in the tube connector to the pipe until the
connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
• Check if there is any damage or foreign
objects on the connected part of the pipe.
• After connecting, check if the pipe and the
connector are securely connected by pulling
them.
Marking
Location
A067094E02
A067097
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
3.
A133779
Mark
Screw threads
Starting Point
FU–27
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE TUBE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket onto the fuel tank.
(b) Set the fuel suction with pump & gage tube
assembly to the fuel tank.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the fuel sender
gage.
(c) Fit the spline of the fuel suction with pump & gage
tube assembly into the keyway of the fuel tank.
(d) Install the retainer.
(1) Using a new retainer, align the mark on the
retainer with the screw-thread starting point of
the fuel tank.
(2) While holding the fuel suction with pump &
gage tube assembly, tighten the retainer one
complete turn by hand.
A151298E01
SST
Rib
A
Mark
A151299E01
(e) Using SST, tighten the retainer one more complete
turn, and position the mark on the retainer into
range A of the fuel tank.
SST 09808-14020 (09808-01410, 09808-01430)
HINT:
• Turn the retainer two complete turns and position
the mark within range A to install the retainer.
• A rib on the retainer can be fitted into the tip of
SST.
FU
FU–28
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
4.
INSTALL FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK
RETURN TUBE
(a) Connect the 2 fuel tank tubes with the 2 clips.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no scratch or foreign
objects on the connecting parts.
• Check that the connector is fully inserted.
• Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar
of the connector.
• After installing the tube joint clip, check if the
tubes are securely connected by puling then.
5.
INSTALL FUEL TANK CUSHION
(a) Install 3 new fuel tank cushions to the fuel tank.
6.
INSTALL FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Set a transmission jack to the fuel tank.
(b) Install the fuel tank and 2 fuel tank bands with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
7.
CONNECT FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Push in the tube connector to the pipe until the
connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no damage or foreign
objects on the connected part of the pipe.
• After connecting, check if the pipe and the
connector are securely connected by pulling
them.
8.
CONNECT FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK
RETURN TUBE
(a) Push in the tube connector to the pipe until the
connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no damage or foreign
objects on the connected part of the pipe.
• After connecting, check if the pipe and the
connector are securely connected by pulling
them.
A133782
FU
A133783
A067103
A067104
2UZ-FE FUEL – FUEL TANK
9.
0 to 3 mm (0 to 0.12 in.)
FU–29
INSTALL NO. 1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Set a transmission jack to the fuel tank protector.
(b) Install the fuel tank protector with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
10. INSTALL FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Install the fuel tank to filler pipe hose to the fuel filler
pipe.
HINT:
Make sure that the hose and pipe are connected as
shown in the illustration.
11. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE (See page FU-5)
Location
Marking
A067096E02
12. INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the 3 screws and rear floor service hole
cover.
(c) Install the rear floor carpet assembly.
FU
EC–10
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR PUMP
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
E4-28 (E2)
E4-32 (AIP)
1.
INSPECT PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Measure the voltage between terminals E4-32 (AIP)
and E4-28 (E2) of the ECM connector.
Voltage:
1.0 to 2.2 V
If the voltage is not as specified, replace the
pressure sensor, wire harness or ECM.
2.
INSPECT VSV FOR AIR INJECTION SYSTEM
(a) Disconnect the connector from the VSV (Procedure
"A").
(b) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the VSV
(Procedure "B").
A133797E01
A133798
(c) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals (Procedure "C").
Resistance
1
EC
2
A133799E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
33 to 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
VSV.
(d) Check that air does not flow from the port as shown
in the illustration (Procedure "D").
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV.
Air
A133800E01
(e) Apply positive battery between the terminals, and
check that air flows from the port (Procedure "E").
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV.
(f) Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the VSV
(Procedure "F").
NOTICE:
Be sure to connect the vacuum hoses correctly.
(g) Connect the connector to the VSV (Procedure "G").
(h) Perform procedures "A" to "G" for the other VSV.
Air
A133801E01
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR PUMP
EC–11
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
3.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page ES-495)
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY (See
page ES-495)
5.
DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE (See page FU-10)
6.
DISCONNECT FUEL NO. 2 HOSE
7.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS FROM INTAKE
MANIFOLD (See page ES-500)
8.
DISCONNECT HOSES FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(See page ES-500)
9.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-501)
10. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-45)
11. REMOVE AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the No.2 air hose from the air switching
valve.
(b) Disconnect the air switching valve connector.
(c) Disconnect the pressure sensor connector for the
air injection system.
(d) Remove the 4 bolts and air pump with bracket
assembly.
A133809
12. REMOVE AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and air pump assembly.
(b) Remove the 3 insulators from the air pump
assembly.
A133810
1
2
INSPECTION
1.
A133804E01
INSPECT AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 2,
and check that air flows.
If operation is not as specified, replace the air pump.
EC
EC–12
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR PUMP
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 3 insulators to the air pump assembly.
(b) Install the air pump assembly with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
(a) Install the air pump assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the pressure sensor connector for the air
injection system.
(c) Connect the air switching valve connector.
(d) Connect the No. 2 air hose to the air switching
valve.
3.
INSTALL WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-53)
4.
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-503)
5.
CONNECT HOSES FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD (See
page ES-504)
6.
CONNECT CONNECTORS FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(See page ES-504)
7.
INSTALL FUEL NO. 2 HOSE
8.
INSTALL FUEL HOSE (See page FU-13)
9.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
A133810
A133809
EC
10. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page ES-496)
11. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
12. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
13. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-5)
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
EC–17
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
A133802
INSPECT NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the VSV for the
air injection system (Procedure "A").
(b) Apply vacuum (30 kPa (306 gf/cm2, 4.35 psi)) to the
vacuum hose, and check that the vacuum does not
decrease (Procedure "B").
If operation is not as specified, replace the No. 2 air
switching valve.
(c) Release the vacuum, and check that an operation
sound is emitted from the No. 2 air switching valve
(Procedure "C").
If operation is not as specified, replace the No. 2 air
switching valve.
(d) Perform procedures "A" to "C" for the other No. 2 air
switching valve.
A133803
EC
EC–18
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
3.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page ES-495)
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY (See
page ES-495)
5.
DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE (See page FU-10)
6.
DISCONNECT FUEL NO. 2 HOSE
7.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS FROM INTAKE
MANIFOLD (See page ES-500)
8.
DISCONNECT HOSES FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(See page ES-500)
9.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-501)
10. REMOVE AIR NO. 2 TUBE
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and 2 gaskets, and disconnect
the air No. 2 tube.
11. REMOVE AIR NO. 3 TUBE
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and 2 gaskets, and disconnect
the air No. 3 tube.
EC
12. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR (See page EM45)
13. REMOVE NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Remove the 2 vacuum hoses from the No. 2 air
switching valves.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts, 2 gaskets and the 2 No. 2 air
switching valves from the water by-pass joint rear.
14. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-45)
A134352
15. REMOVE AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
(See page EC-11)
16. REMOVE PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the vacuum hose from the pressure sensor
and air switching valve.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and pressure sensor from the
air switching valve.
A134350
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
EC–19
17. REMOVE AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and air switching valve from the
air pump bracket.
(b) Remove the No. 1 air hose from the air switching
valve and air pump.
A134351
INSPECTION
Air
1.
INSPECT AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Blow air into port A and check that air is not
discharged from port B.
Port A
Port B
A133805E01
(b) Apply positive battery between the terminals.
(c) Blow air into port A and check that air is discharged
from port B.
If operation is not as specified, replace the air
switching valve.
Port B
Air
Battery
Port A
A133806E01
2.
Port A
INSPECT NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Blow air into port B and check that air is not
discharged from port C.
Port C
Air
Port B
A133807E01
Port A
Port C
Air
Port B
A133808E01
(b) Apply vacuum (30 kPa (306 gf/cm2, 4.35 psi)) to
port A, blow air into port B and check that air is
discharged from port C.
If operation is not as specified, replace the No. 2 air
switching valve.
EC
EC–20
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Install the No. 1 air hose to the air switching valve
and air pump.
(b) Install the air switching valve with the 2 bolts to the
air pump bracket.
Torque: 16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Install the pressure sensor with the 2 bolts to the air
switching valve.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the vacuum hose to the pressure sensor and
air switching valve.
3.
INSTALL AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH BRACKET
(See page EC-12)
4.
INSTALL WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-53)
5.
INSTALL NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Install 2 new gaskets and the 2 No. 2 air switching
valves with the 4 bolts to the water by-pass joint
rear.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the No. 2 air
switching valves.
6.
INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
7.
INSTALL NO. 3 AIR TUBE
(a) Install the 4 nuts and 2 new gaskets, and connect
the No. 3 air tube.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL NO. 2 AIR TUBE
(a) Install the 4 nuts and 2 new gaskets, and connect
the No. 2 air tube.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page
ES-503)
A134351
A134350
EC
A134352
10. CONNECT HOSES FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD (See
page ES-504)
11. CONNECT CONNECTORS FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
(See page ES-504)
12. INSTALL FUEL NO. 2 HOSE
13. INSTALL FUEL HOSE (See page FU-13)
14. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
15. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page ES-496)
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
EC–21
16. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
17. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-4)
18. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-5)
EC
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
EC–23
REMOVAL
A
1.
REMOVE SPARE TIRE
2.
REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER NO. 2 FILTER
(a) Disconnect the canister outlet hose No. 2 from the
charcoal canister.
(1) Deeply push the connector inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(b) Disconnect the canister outlet hose from the fuel
tank filler pipe.
A
Push
A067130E02
(c) Remove a bolt and the charcoal canister filter.
EC
A067131
Connector
Fuel Tank
Vent Hose
Canister Outlet
Hose No. 2
Purge Hose
A
A
Push
A151297E01
3.
REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose from the
charcoal canister.
(1) Deeply push the connector inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(b) Disconnect the canister outlet hose No. 2 from the
charcoal canister.
(1) Deeply push the connector inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the pump module.
(d) Disconnect the purge line hose from the charcoal
canister.
(e) Remove the 3 bolts, and the charcoal canister from
the body.
EC–24
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check the charcoal canister for cracks and
damage.
If there is any cracks or damage, replace the
charcoal canister assembly.
A150754
Purge Port
(b) Check the charcoal canister operation.
(1) While holding the purge port closed, blow air at
1.67 kPa (17.0 gf/cm2, 0.24 psi) into the vent
port, and check that the air flows from the air
inlet port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
charcoal canister assembly
Air Inlet Port
Air
Vent Port
A150755E01
Purge Port
Vacuum
EC
Vent Port
(2) While holding the vent port closed, apply a
vacuum of 1.10 kPa (8.3 mmHg, 0.32 in.Hg)
into the purge port, and check that the air flows
from the air inlet port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
charcoal canister assembly
Air Inlet Port
A150756E01
(c) Check for air leakage.
(1) Remove the air hose between ports A and B.
A150757
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
Port B
Purge Port
Port A
Air Inlet Port
Vent Port
EC–25
(2) Connect the pressure gauge to the vent port of
the charcoal canister.
(3) While holding port B, the purge port and air
inlet port closed with your fingers, leave port A
open and apply pressurized air at 19.6 kPa (0.2
kgf/cm2, 2.81 psi) into the vent port. Check that
the pressure is retained.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
charcoal canister assembly
Pressure Gauge
A150758E01
(d) Check the leak detection pump.
(1) Check that air flows from port A to ports B and
C.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
pump module.
C
A
Air
B
EC
A092453E01
Valve
Battery
Closed
A092454E02
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the
terminals.
(3) Check that the valve is closed.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
pump module.
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EC–1
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
(Purge VSV)
VACUUM SURGE TANK
CHARCOAL CANISTER
CHARCOAL CANISTER
NO. 2 FILTER
VENTILATION VALVE
PUMP MODULE
FUEL TANK CAP
FUEL TANK
A150760E05
EC
EC–2
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK 2 SENSOR 2)
VSV FOR AIR INJECTION
CONTROL (BANK 1)
VSV FOR AIR INJECTION
CONTROL (BANK 2)
EC
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
A/F SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
(BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
A/F SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
A119840E06
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EC–3
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(NO. 2 ASV) (BANK 2)
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(NO. 2 ASV) (BANK 1)
AIR PUMP
EC
AIR SWITCHING VALVE
(ASV)
A119841E05
EC–4
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Control System
Refueling Valve
To Inteke Manifold
Canister
Purge VSV
Vent Line
Purge Line
Fuel Tank
Vent Valve
Air Inlet line
Air Filter
M
Pump Motor
ECM
P
Pressure Sensor
Pump Module
Secondary Air Injection System
EC
TWC
Pressure Sensor
P
Air Pump
Air Switching Valve
VSVs
M
Air Switching
Valve No.2
ECM
Air Injection
Control Driver
A151293E02
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EC–5
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND
GASKETS
(a) Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
HINT:
Separation of the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap,
PCV hose, etc. may cause an engine failure or
engine malfunctions. Disconnection, looseness or
cracks in the parts of the air induction system
between the throttle body and cylinder head will
allow air suction and cause an engine failure or
engine malfunctions.
2.
CHECK AIR TIGHTNESS IN FUEL TANK AND FILLER
PIPE
(a) Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank
(See page FU-24).
(b) Apply pressure to the fuel tank and make the
internal pressure of the air pressure 4 kPa (41 gf/
cm2, 0.58 psi).
(c) Check that the internal pressure of the fuel tank is
maintained for 1 minute.
(d) Check the connections for each hose and pipe.
(e) Check the installed parts on the fuel tank. If there is
no abnormality, replace the fuel tank and filler pipe.
(f) Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
3.
INSPECT FUEL CUT-OFF VALVE AND FILL CHECK
VALVE
(a) Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank
(See page FU-24).
(b) Apply 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi) to the vent port of
the fuel tank.
HINT:
In the condition that the fuel is full, as the float value
of the fill check valve is closed and has no
ventilation, it is necessary to check the fuel amount
(volume).
(c) Remove the fuel tank cap, and check that the
pressure inside the tank drops.
If pressure does not drop, replace the fuel tank
assembly.
(d) Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
A074799
Vent Line Hose
A067134E02
Vent Line Hose
Fuel Tank Cap
A067135E02
EC
EC–6
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
4.
Air Inlet Line Hose
Air
A150753E01
EC
CHECK AIR INLET LINE
(a) Disconnect the air inlet line hose from the charcoal
canister.
(b) Check that there is ventilation in the air inlet line.
(c) Reconnect the air inlet line hose to the charcoal
canister.
EC–26
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
INSTALLATION
A067131
EC
1.
INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the charcoal canister with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the purge line hose to the charcoal
canister.
(c) Connect the connector to the pump module.
(d) Connect the canister outlet hose No. 2 to the
charcoal canister.
(e) Connect the fuel tank hose to the charcoal canister.
2.
INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER NO. 2 FILTER
(a) Install the charcoal canister with a bolt.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the canister outlet hose to the fuel tank
filler pipe.
(c) Connect the canister outlet hose No. 2 to the
charcoal canister.
3.
INSTALL SPARE TIRE
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR PUMP
EC–7
AIR PUMP
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
IDLE UP NO. 2 HOSE
VACUUM HOSE
VENTILATION HOSE
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
EC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A130710E01
EC–8
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR PUMP
ENGINE WIRE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
18 (185, 13)
VSV FOR AIR INJECTION
SYSTEM
ENGINE WIRE
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
INJECTION
CONNECTOR
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
FUEL NO. 2 HOSE
WATER BY-PASS
NO. 7 HOSE
FUEL HOSE
FUEL PIPE NO. 2 CLAMP
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
EC
FUEL PIPE NO. 1 CLAMP
GASKET
VACUUM
HOSE
GASKET
VSV CONNECTOR FOR EVAP
WIRE BRACKET
WATER BY-PASS PIPE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
16 (163, 12)
16 (163, 12)
18 (185, 13)
AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY
WITH BRACKET
O-RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A134407E02
EC–9
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR PUMP
16 (163, 12)
AIR SWITCHING VALVE
PRESSURE SENSOR
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
VACUUM HOSE
AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY
EC
10 (102, 7)
NO. 1 AIR HOSE
x3
INSULATOR
BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A134408E01
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
EC–13
AIR SWITCHING VALVE
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
IDLE UP NO. 2 HOSE
VACUUM HOSE
VENTILATION HOSE
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
EC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119860E02
EC–14
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
ENGINE WIRE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ENGINE WIRE
VSV FOR AIR
INJECTION
SYSTEM
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
INJECTION CONNECTOR
EC
FUEL NO. 2 HOSE
WATER BY-PASS
NO. 7 HOSE
INTAKE MANIFOLD
ASSEMBLY
FUEL HOSE
FUEL PIPE CLAMP NO. 2
FUEL PIPE CLAMP NO. 1
VSV CONNECTOR FOR EVAP
GASKET
VACUUM HOSE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
WIRE BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
ENGINE WIRE
Non-reusable part
A119820E09
EC–15
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
10 (102, 7)
GASKET
10 (102, 7)
10 (102, 7)
AIR NO. 2
TUBE
GASKET
GASKET
GASKET
NO. 2 AIR SWITCHING VALVE
18 (185, 13)
WATER BY-PASS PIPE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR NO. 3 TUBE
GASKET
EC
10 (102, 7)
O-RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A130720E02
EC–16
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR SWITCHING VALVE
AIR SWITCHING VALVE
16 (163, 12)
PRESSURE SENSOR
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
VACUUM HOSE
AIR PUMP
EC
10 (102, 7)
NO. 1 AIR HOSE
x3
INSULATOR
BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A134408E03
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
EC–21
CANISTER
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
EC
SPARE TIRE
C131379E02
EC–22
EC
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
CHARCOAL CANISTER NO. 2 FILTER
A150760E04
EC–26
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
Ohmmeter
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
INSPECTION
1.
Continuity
B016402E01
Ohmmeter
INSPECT PURGE VSV
(a) Inspect the VSV for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
26 to 30 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
VSV.
(b) Inspect the VSV for ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no
continuity between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
No Continuity
B016403E01
(c) Inspect the VSV operation.
(1) Check that air does not flow from ports.
EC
Air
B016404E01
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the
terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from ports.
If operation is not as specified, replace the
VSV.
Air
Battery
B016405E01
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – VENTILATION VALVE
EC–27
VENTILATION VALVE
Clean Hose
Air
Cylinder Head Side
B016486E01
1.
INSPECT VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a clean hose to the ventilation valve.
(b) Inspect the ventilation valve operation.
(1) Blow air into the cylinder head side, and check
that air passes through smoothly.
CAUTION:
Do not suck air through the valve.
Petroleum substances inside the valve are
harmful.
(2) Blow air into the intake manifold side, and
check that air does not passes through
smoothly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the
ventilation valve.
(c) Remove the clean hose from the ventilation valve.
Air
Intake
Manifold
Side
INSPECTION
Clean Hose
B016487E01
EC
EC–28
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
+B
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
HT
INSPECTION
1.
E1
A061830E01
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (for Sensor 1)
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance
Terminal No.
Resistance
1 (HT) ←→ 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 (HT) ←→ 4 (E1)
10 kΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
EC
EC–29
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
+B
HT
2
1
4
3
INSPECTION
1.
E1
A062378E43
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Sensor 2)
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance
Terminal No.
Resistance
1 (HT) ←→ 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 (HT) ←→ 4 (E1)
10 kΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
sensor.
EC
EC–30
2UZ-FE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK CAP
FUEL TANK CAP
INSPECTION
1.
Gasket
A076682E05
EC
INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check if the cap and/or gasket are
deformed or damaged.
IT–1
2UZ-FE INTAKE – INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
2UZ-FE INTAKE
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
VACUUM SWITCHING
VALVE ASSEMBLY
(for ACIS)
INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY:
INTAKE AIR
CONTROL VALVE
A137561E01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
A134353
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE OPERATION
(a) Start the engine.
(b) While the engine is idling, check that the actuator
rod moves.
IT
IT–2
2UZ-FE INTAKE – INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the VSV connector, and check that the
actuator rod returns.
If operation is not as specified, inspect the intake air
control valve, VSV and ECM.
Disconnect
A134354E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) With 39.9 kPa (300 mmHg, 11.8 in.Hg) of vacuum
applied to the actuator, check that the actuator rod
moves (procedure [A]).
(b) One minute after applying the vacuum in procedure
[A], check that the actuator rod does not return.
If operation is not as specified, replace the intake
manifold.
2.
INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between each terminal.
Resistance:
33 to 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
A134355
Continuity
Ohmmeter
IT
S004525E06
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no
continuity between each terminal and the body.
Resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
No continuity
Ohmmeter
S004524E05
(c) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
Air
E
Filter
FI06393E09
2UZ-FE INTAKE – INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
IT–3
(d) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(e) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
Air
E
F
S004523E08
IT
2UZ-FE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
EX–3
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Install a new gasket and front pipe to exhaust
manifold.
(b) Install the exhaust pipe front with 2 nuts.
Torque: 62 N*m (633 kgf*cm, 46 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 new gaskets and the front pipe to
exhaust manifold.
(b) Install the exhaust pipe front with 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: Nut
62 N*m (633 kgf*cm, 46 ft.*lbf)
Bolt
48 N*m (489 kgf*cm, 35 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY CENTER
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the free length to
the compression spring.
Minimum length:
40.5 mm (1.5945 in.)
If the free length is less than minimum, replace the
compression spring.
(b) Install a new gasket on the exhaust pipe assembly
front.
(c) Install the exhaust pipe assembly center with 2 bolts
and 2 springs.
Torque: 43 N*m (440 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY TAIL
(a) Install a new gasket on the exhaust pipe center.
(b) Install the tail pipe with 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N*m (489 kgf*cm, 35 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1
Sensor 2)
(a) Install heated oxygen sensor to exhaust pipe front.
Torque: 44 N*m (450 kgf*cm, 33 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
HINT:
After installing heated oxygen sensor, check that
sensor wire is not twisted. If it is twisted, remove the
heated oxygen sensor and reinstall it.
6.
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 2
Sensor 2)
(a) Install heated oxygen sensor to exhaust pipe front.
Torque: 44 N*m (450 kgf*cm, 33 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
HINT:
After installing heated oxygen sensor, check that
sensor wire is not twisted. If it is twisted, remove the
heated oxygen sensor and reinstall it.
7.
INSPECT EXHAUST GAS LEAK
Gasket
Front
Pipe
A072559E01
EX
EX–1
2UZ-FE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
EXHAUST PIPE
2UZ-FE EXHAUST
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY TAIL
48 (489, 35)
48 (489, 35)
GASKET
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY CENTER
43 (440, 32)
COMPRESSION SPRING
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
43 (440, 32)
GASKET
NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT
PIPE ASSEMBLY
EX
GASKET
44 (450, 33)
COMPRESSION SPRING
48 (489, 35)
62 (633, 46)
GASKET
GASKET
44 (450, 33)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
62 (633, 46)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119776E01
EX–2
2UZ-FE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1
Sensor 2)
(a) Disconnect a heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Remove the heated oxygen sensor.
2.
REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 2
Sensor 2)
(a) Disconnect a heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Remove the heated oxygen sensor.
3.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY TAIL
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, exhaust pipe support and tail
pipe.
4.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY CENTER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
(b) Remove the 4 exhaust pipe supports and exhaust
pipe center.
5.
REMOVE NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and No. 2 exhaust front
pipe assembly.
6.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and exhaust pipe assembly
front.
A067109
A067110
EX
CO–14
2UZ-FE COOLING – RADIATOR
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO.1
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover.
3.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support upper.
4.
REMOVE RADIATOR RESERVE TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the reserve tank hose from the radiator.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and reserve tank.
5.
SEPARATE FAN SHROUD
(a) Disconnect the reserve tank hose from the radiator.
(b) Disconnect the radiator hose No. 1 from the
radiator.
(c) Disconnect the oil cooler inlet hose from the
radiator.
(d) Disconnect the oil cooler outlet hose from the
radiator.
(e) Disconnect the radiator hose No. 2 from the
radiator.
A072532
A072577
(f)
Remove the 2 bolts, and separate the fan shroud.
HINT:
Temporarily put the separated fan shroud at an
appropriate location in the engine room.
CO
A072533
A067113
6.
REMOVE RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and radiator.
7.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 radiator support No. 1.
8.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT NO.2
(a) Remove the 2 radiator support No. 2.
9.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT NO.1 BUSH
(a) Remove the 4 radiator support No. 1 bush.
2UZ-FE COOLING – RADIATOR
CO–15
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the tabs of the radiator support through the
radiator service holes.
(b) Install the radiator assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL FAN SHROUD
(a) Insert the tabs in the slots shown in the illustration,
attach the fan shroud with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL RADIATOR RESERVE TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the reserve tank with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the reserve tank hose to the radiator.
4.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
5.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK (See page CO-4)
A067114
A072540
CO
2UZ-FE COOLING – COOLING SYSTEM
CO–1
COOLING SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKAGE
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Thermal expansion will
cause hot engine coolant and steam to blow out
from the radiator.
(b) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator
cap tester.
(c) Warm up the engine.
(d) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2, 17.1 psi), then
check that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator and
water pump for leakage. If there are no signs of
external coolant leakage, check the heater core,
cylinder block and cylinder head.
(e) Reinstall the radiator cap.
A067116
2.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
(a) The engine coolant should be between the LOW
and FULL lines when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leakage and add Toyota Super
Long Life Coolant or similar high quality ethylene
glycol based non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite,
and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic
acid technology up to the FULL line.
3.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not
remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Thermal expansion will
cause hot engine coolant and steam to blow out
from the radiator.
(b) Check for any excessive deposits of rust or scale
around the radiator cap and radiator filler hole; the
coolant should be free of oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
CO
CO–2
2UZ-FE COOLING – COOLING SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FLUID COUPLING ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the fluid coupling for damage or silicon oil
leaks.
If necessary, replace the fluid coupling.
2.
INSPECT FAN BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the fan pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the pulley bracket.
P021660
B007456
CO
2UZ-FE COOLING – COOLANT
CO–3
COOLANT
REPLACEMENT
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove
the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are
still hot. Thermal expansion will cause hot engine
coolant and steam to blow out from the radiator.
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
(b) Remove the service hole cover from the engine
under cover No. 1.
(c) Install a vinyl hose onto the drain on the radiator
side.
(d) Fix the vinyl hose with tape.
Vinyl Hose
Tape
A070279E01
(e) Loosen the 3 drain plugs on the engine and radiator,
and drain the coolant.
(f) Drain the coolant from the reservoir tank.
(g) Tighten the 3 drain plugs.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf) for the
engine
(h) Remove the vinyl hose from the radiator.
Drain Plug
2.
A070477E01
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Slowly fill the system with engine coolant.
Capacity:
12.3 liters (13.0 US qts, 10.8 lmp. qts)
HINT:
• Use of improper coolants may damage the
engine cooling system.
• Use only Toyota Super Long Life Coolant or
similar high quality ethylene glycol based nonsilicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate
coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid
technology (coolant with long-life hybrid organic
acid technology consists of a combination of low
phosphates and organic acids).
• New Toyota vehicles are filled with Toyota Super
Long Life Coolant (color is pink, premixed
ethylene glycol concentration is approximately 50
% and freezing temperature is -35°C (-31°F)).
When replacing the coolant, Toyota Super Long
Life Coolant is recommended.
• Observe the coolant level inside the radiator by
pressing the inlet and outlet radiator hoses
several times by hand. If the coolant level goes
down, add the coolant.
CO
CO–4
2UZ-FE COOLING – COOLANT
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
3.
CO
NOTICE:
Do not substitute plain water for engine coolant.
Install the radiator cap securely.
Bleed the cooling system.
(1) Open the heater water valve while warming up
the engine.
(2) Maintain the engine speed at 2,000 to 2,500
rpm and warm up the engine.
Stop the engine and wait until the coolant cools
down.
Add coolant into the reservoir until the coolant level
is FULL.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator
cap tester.
(b) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2 17.1 psi), then
check for leakage.
2UZ-FE COOLING – WATER PUMP
CO–5
WATER PUMP
2UZ-FE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
WATER INLET HOUSING
CO
WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
TIMING BELT
A137956E01
CO–6
2UZ-FE COOLING – WATER PUMP
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TIMING BELT
(a) Remove the timing belt (See page EM-16).
2.
REMOVE WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Disconnect the water bypass hose from the water
inlet housing.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts holding the water inlet housing
to the water pump.
(c) Disconnect the water inlet housing from the front
water bypass joint, and remove the water inlet
housing w/ water inlet.
3.
REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts, 2 stud bolts, nut, water pump
and gasket.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the water bypass pipe.
A074954
B004461
INSPECTION
1.
Water
Hole
Air Hole
B004067E01
CO
New O-ring
INSTALLATION
1.
Connect
B004463E01
INSPECT WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check the air hole and water hole for
coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump
assembly.
(b) Turn the pulley and check that the water pump
bearing moves smoothly and quietly.
If necessary, replace the water pump assembly.
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the water bypass pipe end.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
(c) Connect the water pump to the water bypass pipe
end.
(d) Install the water pump and new gasket with the 5
bolts, 2 stud bolts and nut. Uniformly tighten the
bolts, stud bolts and nut in several passes.
Torque: Bolt
21 N*m (215 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
Stud bolt and nut
18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
2UZ-FE COOLING – WATER PUMP
2.
CO–7
INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the water inlet housing and water pump.
(1) Using a razor blade and gasket scraper,
remove all the old packing (FIPG) material from
the gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the sealing groove of water
inlet housing as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three
Bond 1282B or equivalent
(1) Cut the opening of a nozzle for seal packing to
a diameter of 2 to 3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.), and
install it.
(2) Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
(3) Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall cap.
(c) Install a new O-ring to the water inlet housing.
(d) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
(e) Attach the water inlet housing end to the front water
bypass joint hole.
(f) Install the water inlet and housing assembly with the
2 bolts. Alternately tighten the bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
Seal Width 2 to 3 mm
New O-ring
A074953E01
3.
INSTALL TIMING BELT
(a) Install timing belt (See page EM-19).
CO
CO–8
2UZ-FE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
THERMOSTAT
2UZ-FE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
WATER INLET HOUSING
CO
A130721E02
2UZ-FE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
CO–9
REMOVAL
HINT:
Removal of the thermostat would have an adverse effect,
causing a lowering of cooling efficiency. Do not remove the
thermostat, even if the engine tends to overheat.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2.
SEPARATE WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Remove the 3 nuts, and separate the water inlet
from the water inlet housing.
3.
REMOVE THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat.
(b) Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
A066664
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT WATER INLET WITH THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The valve opening temperature is inscribed on the
thermostat.
A075918E01
(a) Immerse the thermostat in water, then gradually
heat the water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the
thermostat.
Valve opening temperature:
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified,
replace the thermostat.
A075919E01
Valve Lift
A075920E02
(c) Check the valve lift.
Valve lift:
8.0 mm (0.31 in.) or more at 95°C (203°F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the
thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the
thermostat is at low temperature (below 40°C
(104°F)).
If not fully closed, replace the thermostat.
CO
CO–10
2UZ-FE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
INSTALLATION
Jiggle Valve
30° 30°
A066665E01
CO
1.
INSTALL THERMOSTAT
(a) Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
(b) Insert the thermostat into the water inlet housing
with the jiggle valve facing straight upward.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 30° of either side
of the prescribed position.
2.
INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Install the water inlet with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 19 N*m (195 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
3.
FILL UP ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
2UZ-FE COOLING – RADIATOR
CO–11
RADIATOR
2UZ-FE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
RADIATOR
ASSEMBLY
FAN SHROUD
CO
A119815E03
CO–12
2UZ-FE COOLING – RADIATOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RADIATOR CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• If the radiator cap is contaminated, rinse it with
water.
• Before using a radiator cap tester, wet the relief
valve and pressure valve with engine coolant or
water.
• When performing the following steps [A] and [B],
keep the tester at an angle of 30° or more above
the horizontal.
(a) Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump and check
that air comes from the vacuum valve [A].
Pumping speed:
1 push every 3 seconds or more
NOTICE:
Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air does not come from the vacuum valve, replace
the reservoir cap.
(b) Pump the tester, then measure the relief valve
opening pressure [B].
Pumping speed:
1 push every second
NOTICE:
The above pumping speed is for the first
pumping only (in order to close the vacuum
valve). After the first pumping, the pumping
speed can be reduced.
HINT:
Use the tester's maximum reading as the opening
pressure.
Standard opening pressure:
93 to 123 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf*cm2, 13.5 to 17.8
psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
78 kPa (0.8 kgf*cm2, 11.4 psi)
If the opening pressure is less than the minimum,
replace the radiator cap.
Radiator Cap Tester
30qQTOQTG
Radiator Cap
Z000570E04
CO
ON-VEHICLE CLEANING
1.
A073603E04
INSPECT FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
(a) If the fins are clogged, wash them with water or a
steam cleaner, then dry them with compressed air.
NOTICE:
• If the distance between the steam cleaner and
core is too small, there is a possibility of
damaging the fins, so keep to the following
injection distances.
Injection Pressure kPa (kg/cm2, psi)
Injection Distance mm (in.)
2,942 to 4,903 (30 to 50, 427 to 711)
300 (11.811)
4,903 to 7,845 (50 to 80, 711 to 1,138)
500 (19.685)
2UZ-FE COOLING – RADIATOR
CO–13
• If the fins are bent, straighten them with a
screwdriver or pliers.
• Be careful not to expose electronic
components to water.
CO
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–11
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove engine assembly (See page EM-80).
2.
REMOVE TIMING BELT
(a) Remove timing belt (See page EM-16).
3.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page
EM-112)
4.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See
page ES-492)
5.
REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY (See page LU-17)
6.
REMOVE NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
EM-115)
7.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
EM-116)
8.
REMOVE OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE (See page EM115)
9.
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page EM115)
10. REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 8 bolts.
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench for the hexagon head
bolt.
B001044
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pump by prying
the portions between the oil pump and cylinder
block.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of
the cylinder block and oil pump.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the cylinder block.
11. REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL (See page EM-118)
B000951
DISASSEMBLY
1.
A134402
REMOVE OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Remove the plug, compression spring and relief
valve.
LU
LU–12
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
2.
REMOVE OIL PUMP ROTOR SET
(a) Remove the 10 screws, pump body cover and the
drive and driven rotors.
A134403
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Coat the valve with engine oil and check that it falls
smoothly into the valve hole under its own weight.
If it dose not, replace the relief valve. If necessary,
replace the oil pump assembly.
2.
INSPECT OIL PUMP ROTOR SET
(a) Place the drive and driven rotors into the pump body
with the marks facing the pump body cover side.
B002609
B002612
(b) Inspect the rotors for tip clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard tip clearance:
0.060 to 0.180 mm (0.0024 to 0.0071 in.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.18 mm (0.0071 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the rotors as a set.
LU
B002613
B002614
(c) Inspect the rotors for side clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge and precision straight
edge, measure the clearance between the
rotors and precision straight edge.
Standard side clearance:
0.030 to 0.090 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum side clearance:
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
If the side clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the rotors as a set. If
necessary, replace the oil pump assembly.
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–13
(d) Inspect the rotor for body clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the driven rotor and body.
Standard body clearance:
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.325 mm (0.0128 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the rotors as a set. If
necessary, replace the oil pump assembly.
B002615
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL PUMP ROTOR SET
(a) Place the drive and driven rotors into the pump body
with the marks facing the pump body cover side.
B002612
(b) Install the oil pump body cover with the 10 screws.
Torque: 10 N*m (105 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
A134403
2.
INSTALL OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Insert the relief valve and compression spring into
the oil pump body hole.
(b) Install the plug.
Torque: 49 N*m (500 kgf*cm, 36 ft.*lbf)
LU
A134402
LU–14
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
INSTALLATION
1.
A
B
A
Seal Width
2 to 3 mm
B
B000960E04
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the oil pump and cylinder block.
(1) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the old
packing (FIPG) material from the gasket
surfaces and sealing groove.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all
the loose material.
(3) Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b) Install a new oil pump seal (See page EM-161).
(c) Apply seal packing to the oil pump as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or equivalent
NOTICE:
Avoid applying an excessive amount to the
surface. Be particularly careful around the oil
passages.
(1) Use a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 to 3 mm
(0.08 to 0.12 in.) opening.
(2) Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
(3) Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube
and reinstall the cap.
(d) Install a new O-ring to the cylinder block.
(e) Engage the spline teeth of the oil pump drive gear
with the large teeth of the crankshaft, and slide the
oil pump on the crankshaft.
New O-ring
Engage
LU
P021388E02
A
A
(f)
A
E
C
D
A
B
B000950E01
Install the new pump with the 8 bolts. Uniformly
tighten the bolts in several steps.
Torque: 14 mm
31 N*m (311 kgf*cm, 23 ft.*lbf)
For others
16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page EM164)
3.
INSTALL OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE (See page EM-165)
4.
INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
EM-164)
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–15
5.
INSTALL NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
EM-166)
6.
INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY (See page LU-17)
7.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See
page ES-492)
8.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page
EM-173)
9.
INSTALL TIMING BELT
(a) Install timing belt (See page EM-19).
10. INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install engine assembly (See page EM-87).
LU
LU–18
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – ENGINE OIL COOLER
INSTALLATION
LU
1.
INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the oil cooler contact surface on the cooler
mounting.
(b) Install a new O-ring to the oil cooler.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the head of the union bolt.
(d) Install the plate washer and union bolt.
Torque: 69 N*m (700 kgf*cm, 51 ft.*lbf)
(e) Connect the 2 oil cooler hoses to the cooler.
2.
INSTALL OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY (See page LU-4)
3.
ADD ENGINE OIL (See page LU-5)
4.
FILL UP ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
5.
INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEAKS
6.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK (See page CO-4)
7.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – LUBRICATION SYSTEM
LU–1
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
(a) Warm up the engine, then stop the engine and wait
for 5 minutes.
(b) Check that the engine oil level is between the low
level and full level marks on the level gauge.
If low, check for leakage and top oil up to the full
level mark.
NOTICE:
Do not fill with engine oil to above the full level
mark.
2.
CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
(a) Check the oil for deterioration, water intrusion,
discoloration or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
SAE 5W-30 is the best choice for good fuel
economy and good starting in cold weather.
If SAE 5W-30 is not available, use SAE 10W-30.
However, it should be replaced with SAE 5W-30 at
the next oil replacement.
3.
INSPECT OIL PRESSURE
(a) Remove the engine under cover.
(b) Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector.
Recommended Viscosity (SAE):
PREFERRED
TEMPERATUER RANGE ANTICIPATED BEFORE NEXT OIL CHANGE
B000319E02
(c) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, remove the oil
pressure switch.
A067119E02
Oil Pressure Switch
Oil Pressure Gauge
A067120E02
(d) Install the oil pressure gauge.
(e) Warm up the engine.
(f) Inspect the oil pressure.
Oil pressure
When Idling
29 kPa (0.3 kgf*cm2, 4.2 psi) or more
At 3,000 rpm
294 to 588 kPa (3.0 to 6.0kgf*cm2, 43
to 85 psi)
LU
LU–2
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – LUBRICATION SYSTEM
Adhesive
P013638E07
LU
(g) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure
switch.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond
1344 or equivalent
(h) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, install the oil
pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine within 1 hour of
installation.
(i) Connect the oil pressure switch connector.
(j) Start the engine and check for engine oil leakage.
LU–3
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL FILTER
OIL FILTER
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY
LU
A119819E04
LU–4
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL FILTER
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• Prolonged and repeated contact with engine oil will
cause the removal of natural oils from the skin,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In
addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful
contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
• Precautions should be taken when replacing engine
oil to minimize the risk of your skin making contact
with used engine oil.
• Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or
use waterless hand cleaner to remove any used
engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
• For environmental protection, used oil and used oil
filters must be disposed of only at designated
disposal sites.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the engine under cover seal No. 3.
(b) Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the engine
oil.
(c) Clean the oil pan drain plug and install a new gasket
and it.
Torque: 39 N*m (398 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
3.
REMOVE OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-07501
A072683
SST
A072684E01
INSTALLATION
LU
1.
A072685
INSTALL OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter
mounting.
(b) Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with clean engine
oil.
(c) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket
contacts the seat of the filter mounting.
LU–5
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL FILTER
(d) Using SST, give it an additional 3/4 turn to set the
filter.
SST 09228-07501
3/4 Turn
2.
SST
ADD ENGINE OIL
(a) Fill with fresh engine oil.
Capacity
Drain and refill with oil filter change
6.2 liters (6.5 US qts, 5.5 lmp. qts)
Drain and refill without oil filter
change
5.7 liters (6.0 US qts, 5.0 lmp. qts)
Dry fill
7.1 liters (7.5 US qts, 6.2 lmp. qts)
A072686E01
(b) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
3.
INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEAKS
4.
INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEVEL
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
LU
LU–6
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
TIMING BELT
LU
CRANKSHAFT
TIMING PULLEY
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
A119928E03
LU–7
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
LU
A119819E05
LU–8
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
OIL PUMP SEAL
LU
A119825E03
LU–9
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
A119930E02
LU
LU–10
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
DRIVEN ROTOR
10 (105, 8)
OIL PUMP BODY
x10
DRIVE ROTOR
OIL PUMP BODY COVER
OIL PUMP SEAL
OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
COMPRESSION SPRING
LU
PLUG
49 (500, 36)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A134406E01
LU–16
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – ENGINE OIL COOLER
ENGINE OIL COOLER
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
LU
OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY
A119819E07
2UZ-FE LUBRICATION – ENGINE OIL COOLER
LU–17
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
2.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL (See page LU-4)
3.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
4.
REMOVE OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY (See page LU-4)
5.
REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 oil cooler hoses from oil cooler.
(b) Remove the union bolt, plate washer and the oil
cooler.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the oil cooler.
LU
2UZ-FE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
IG–1
IGNITION SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY AND SPARK
TEST
(a) Confirm DTCs (See page ES-35).
NOTICE:
If any DTCs are indicated, carry out
troubleshooting in accordance with the
procedures for those DTCs.
(b) Check that a spark occurs.
(1) Remove the ignition coils (See page EM-86).
(2) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, remove
the spark plugs.
(3) Install the spark plugs to each ignition coil, and
connect the ignition coil connectors.
(4) Disconnect the 8 injector connectors.
(5) Ground the spark plugs.
(6) Check if a spark occurs while the engine is
being cranked.
NOTICE:
• Be sure to ground the spark plugs when
checking.
• Replace the ignition coil if it is subjected
to an impact.
• Do not crank the engine for more than 2
seconds.
(c) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, install the
spark plugs.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the ignition coils.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
IG
IG–2
2UZ-FE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
Ohmmeter
Ground
IG00147E05
INSPECT SPARK PLUG
NOTICE:
• Never use a wire brush for cleaning.
• Never attempt to adjust the electrode gap on a
used spark plug.
• The spark plug should be replaced every 200,000
km (120,000 miles).
(a) Check the electrode.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance.
Correct insulation resistance:
10 MΩ or more
If the resistance is below the specified range,
go to procedure "A".
HINT:
If an ohmmeter is not available, the following
simple inspection provides fairly accurate
results.
(b) Simple Method:
(1) Quickly race the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(2) Remove the spark plug.
(3) Visually check the spark plug.
(4) If the electrode is dry... OK.
(5) If the electrode is wet... Go to procedure "B".
(6) Reinstall the spark plug.
B001301
(c) Check the spark plug for thread or insulator damage
(Procedure "B").
If damaged, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO made
NGK made
SK20R11
IFR6A11
IG00316
(d) Measure the spark plug electrode gap (Procedure
"A")
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than the maximum, replace the
spark plug.
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
IG
1.1 mm
(0.043 in.)
B002101E09
2UZ-FE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
IG–3
(e) Clean the spark plugs.
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to
dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure:
Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration:
20 seconds or less
HINT:
If there are traces of oil, remove them with gasoline
before using a spark plug cleaner.
B062019
2.
INSPECT VVT SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance:
Cold:
835 to 1,400 Ω
Hot:
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" above mean the temperature
of the coils themselves. "Cold" is from -10°C
(14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C
(122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
3.
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Resistance:
Cold:
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot:
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" above mean the temperature
of the coils themselves. "Cold" is from -10°C
(14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C
(122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
IG
ST–10
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-10)
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
3.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
(a) Disconnect the battery negative terminal.
4.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and throttle body cover subassembly.
5.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY (See
page ES-495)
6.
DISCONNECT FUEL HOSE (See page FU-10)
7.
DISCONNECT NO. 2 FUEL HOSE (See page EM-82)
8.
DISCONNECT FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose assembly.
9.
SEPARATE ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the 8 fuel injector connectors.
(b) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(c) Disconnect the water temperature sensor
connector.
(d) Remove the 3 bolts and separate the engine wire
harness.
10. DISCONNECT NO. 7 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
(a) Disconnect the No. 7 water by-pass hose.
11. DISCONNECT WATER BY-PASS HOSE
(a) Disconnect the water by-pass hose.
12. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and 4 nuts.
(b) Remove the intake manifold and 2 gaskets.
13. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Separate the No. 2 engine wire.
(b) Remove the nut and water by-pass pipe subassembly.
14. REMOVE REAR WATER BY-PASS JOINT RH
(a) Remove the 4 nuts, water by-pass joint and 2
gaskets.
15. REMOVE AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY (See page EC-11)
ST
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
ST–11
16. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the starter connector.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the starter cable.
(c) Remove the bolt and disconnect the engine wire
protector.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
A066669
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the terminal C wire.
(b) Remove the 2 through bolts.
(c) Pull out the starter yoke assembly with the armature
assembly.
(d) Remove the O-ring from the starter yoke assembly.
2.
REMOVE STARTER BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws with O-ring and end cover
from the field frame.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the field frame.
A074961
B004654
(c) Using a screwdriver, hold the spring back and
disconnect the brush from the brush holder.
(d) Disconnect the 4 brushes, and remove the brush
holder.
3.
REMOVE STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the starter armature assembly from starter
yoke assembly.
4.
REMOVE STARTER CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and starter drive housing.
P010568
ST
A074962
ST–12
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
Starter
Housing
Idle Gear
(b) Remove the return spring, idler gear, bearing and
starter clutch sub-assembly from the starter
housing.
Bearing
Return Spring
Starter Clutch
Sub-assembly
B004552E01
(c) Using a magnetic finger, remove the steel ball from
the clutch shaft hole.
Magnetic Finger
ST00948E02
ST
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
ST–13
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT STARTER ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 3 to 5 seconds to
avoid burning out the coil.
(a) Do pull-in test.
(1) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal
C.
(2) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as
shown. Check that the clutch pinion gear
moves outward.
Terminal 50
Terminal C
Battery
A074957E01
(b) Do holding test.
(1) With battery connected as above with the
clutch pinion gear out, disconnect the negative
(-) lead from terminal C. Check that the pinion
hear remains out.
Disconnect
Battery
Terminal C
A074958E01
(c) Inspect clutch pinion gear return.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the
switch body. Check that the clutch pinion gear
returns inward.
Disconnect
Battery
A074959E01
Terminal 50
Terminal 30
Battery
Ammeter
A074960E01
(d) Perform the operation test without load.
(1) Connect the field coil lead wire to terminal C.
Torque: 5.9 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 52 in.*lbf)
(2) Grip the starter in a vise.
(3) Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter
as shown.
(4) Check that the ammeter reads the specified
current.
Specified current (for standard area):
90 A or less at 11.5 V
Specified current (for cold area):
100 A or less at 11.5 V
ST
ST–14
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
2.
INSPECT STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect commutator for dirty and burnt surface.
If the surface of the commutator is dirty or burned,
polish the part with sandpaper (#400) or replace the
armature.
(b) Inspect commutator for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is
continuity between the segments, replace the
armature.
If there is no continuity between any segments,
replace the armature.
Continuity
Ohmmeter
S000054E05
(c) Inspect commutator for ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no
continuity between the commutator and
armature core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature
assembly.
No Continuity
Ohmmeter
S000055E05
(d) Inspect commutator circle runout.
(1) Place the armature on the V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial gauge, measure the circuit runout.
Maximum circle runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum,
correct it on a lathe.
S000056
(e) Using vernier calipers, measure the commutator
diameter.
Standard diameter:
35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
Minimum diameter:
34.0 mm (1.339 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the
armature assembly.
ST
S000057
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
ST–15
(f)
Measure the undercut depth of commutator.
Standard undercut depth:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Minimum undercut depth:
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
If the undercut depth is less than the minimum,
correct it with a hacksaw blade.
(g) Inspect the bearings.
(1) Check that the bearing rotates smoothly.
ST00040
3.
Continuity
INSPECT STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect field coil for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is
continuity between the lead wire and field coil
brush lead.
If there is no continuity, replace the starter yoke
assembly.
P010588E01
(b) Inspect shunt coil for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between shunt coil terminals (A) and (B).
Standard resistance:
1.5 to 1.9 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
starter yoke assembly.
Ohmmeter
(B)
(A)
4.
INSPECT BRUSH
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the brush length.
Standard length:
15.0 mm (0.591 in.)
Minimum length:
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
If the length is less than the minimum, replace the
brush holder and starter yoke assembly.
5.
INSPECT STARTER BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no
continuity between the positive and negative brush
holders.
If there is continuity, replace the brush holder.
S002267E02
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P021088E05
ST
ST–16
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
(b) Take the pull scale reading the instant the brush
spring separates from the brush.
Standard spring installed load:
21.5 to 27.5 N (2.2 to 2.8 kgf, 4.8 to 6.2 lbf)
Minimum spring installed load:
12.7 N (1.3 kgf, 2.9 lbf)
If spring load is less than the minimum, replace the
brush springs.
ST00019
6.
INSPECT STARTER CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Rotate the pinion gear clockwise, and check that it
turns freely. Try to rotate the pinion gear
counterclockwise and check that it locks.
If necessary, replace the clutch sub-assembly.
7.
INSPECT STARTER MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the pull-in coil continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is
continuity between terminal 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, replace the starter
magnetic switch assembly.
Free
Lock
P010821E05
Ohmmeter
Continuity
Terminal 50
Terminal C
B012319E02
(b) Check the holding coil continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is
continuity between terminals 50 and switch
body.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnet
starter switch assembly.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
Terminal 50
B012320E02
REASSEMBLY
1.
ST
Idle Gear
Bearing Steel Ball
Return Spring
Starter Housing
Starter Clutch Sub-assembly
A072547E01
INSTALL STARTER CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply grease to the steel ball, return spring, clutch
rollers and starter idler pinions.
(b) Install the steel ball.
(c) Install a new O-ring to the starter housing.
(d) Insert the return spring into the magnet starter
switch hole.
(e) Install the starter clutch sub-assembly, idler gear
and bearing.
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
(f)
ST–17
Install the starter housing to the magnet switch
assembly with the 2 screws.
Torque: 9.3 N*m (95 kgf*cm, 82 in.*lbf)
A074962
2.
P010568
INSTALL STARTER BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the claw of the brush holder with the claw
groove of the starter yoke assembly.
(b) Place the brush holder on the starter yoke
assembly.
(c) Using a screwdriver, hold the brush spring back.
(d) Connect the brush into the brush holder.
(e) Connect the 4 brushes.
NOTICE:
Check that the positive (+) lead wires are not
grounded.
(f) Install an O-ring to the groove of the starter yoke.
(g) Install 2 new O-rings and the end cover with the 2
screws.
Torque: 3.8 N*m (39 kgf*cm, 34 in.*lbf)
B004654
3.
INSTALL STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the groove of the starter yoke
assembly.
(b) Align the protrusion of the starter yoke assembly
with the groove of the magnetic switch.
B012328
ST
ST–18
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
(c) Install the starter yoke assembly with the 2 through
bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N*m (95 kgf*cm, 82 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the terminal C wire with the nut.
Torque: 5.9 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 52 in.*lbf)
A074961
ST
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
ST–19
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the starter assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the engine wire protector with the bolt.
(c) Connect the starter cable with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 86 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the starter connector.
2.
INSTALL AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY (See page EC-12)
3.
INSTALL REAR WATER BY-PASS JOINT RH
(a) Install 2 new gaskets to the cylinder head.
(b) Install the 4 nuts holding the water by-pass joint to
the cylinder heads. Alternately tighten the nuts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the water by-pass pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
(c) Push the water by-pass pipe end into the pipe hole
of the water pump.
(d) Install the water by-pass pipe with the bolt.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the wire clamp to the bracket of the water bypass pipe.
5.
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
(a) Install 2 new gaskets to the cylinder head.
(b) Install the intake manifold with the 6 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: Bolt
18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
Nut
18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
6.
CONNECT WATER BY-PASS HOSE
(a) Connect the water by-pass hose.
7.
CONNECT NO. 7 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
(a) Connect the No. 7 water by-pass hose.
8.
INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
(a) Install the engine wire with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.2 N*m (83 kgf*cm, 72 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the water temperature sensor connector,
(c) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
(d) Connect the 8 fuel injector connectors.
9.
CONNECT FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the fuel vapor feed hose assembly.
10. CONNECT NO. 2 FUEL HOSE
(a) Connect the No. 2 fuel hose.
11. CONNECT FUEL HOSE (See page FU-13)
12. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner hose assembly.
ST
ST–20
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
13. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-3)
14. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAK (See page
CO-4)
15. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK (See page FU-5)
16. INSTALL THROTTLE BODY COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Torque: 7.5 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
17. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
(a) Connect the battery negative terminal.
ST
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTING SYSTEM
ST–1
STARTING SYSTEM
2UZ-FE STARTING
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- ACC CUT RELAY
- STARTER RELAY
ST
A119840E07
ST–2
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTING SYSTEM
STARTER
ST
A119821E03
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTING SYSTEM
ST–3
IGNITION SWITCH
ST
C131333E05
ST–23
2UZ-FE STARTING – IGNITION SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER (See
page SR-9)
2.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER
(a) Remove the steering column upper cover.
3.
REMOVE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the ignition switch connector and unlock warning switch connector.
(b) Remove the clamp.
(c) Remove the 2 screws and ignition switch.
B062162
INSPECTION
ACC
LOCK
1.
ON
START
4
8
3
7
2
6
1
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the switch continuity.
Standard
Terminal No.
Switch Position
Specified Condition
Between all terminals
LOCK
No continuity
No Pin
B052423E09
2-3
ACC
Continuity
2-3-4
6-7
ON
Continuity
1-2-4
6-7-8
START
Continuity
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
INSTALLATION
B062162
1.
INSTALL IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the ignition switch with the 2 screws.
(b) Install the clamp.
(c) Connect the un-lock warning switch connector.
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER
(a) Install the steering column upper cover.
3.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER (See
page SR-21)
ST
ST–4
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
STARTER
2UZ-FE STARTING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
THROTTLE BODY COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CLEANER HOSE ASSEMBLY
ST
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119814E03
ST–5
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
18 (185, 13)
8.2 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
ENGINE WIRE
GASKET
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
8.2 (83, 72 in.*lbf)
GASKET
REAR WATER
BY-PASS JOINT RH
NO. 7 WATER
BY-PASS HOSE
NO. 2 FUEL HOSE
FUEL HOSE
INTAKE MANIFOLD
ASSEMBLY
GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
ST
Non-reusable part
A139365E01
ST–6
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
FUEL VAPOR FEED
HOSE ASSEMBLY
ST
A119779E01
ST–7
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
16 (163, 12)
STARTER ASSEMBLY
AIR PUMP ASSEMBLY
18 (185, 13)
9.8 (100, 7.2)
WATER BY-PASS PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
O-RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
ST
Non-reusable part
A119821E04
ST–8
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
39 (400, 29)
ST
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119927E03
ST–9
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER
9.3 (95, 82 in.*lbf)
IDLER GEAR
BEARING
O-RING
MAGNETIC SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
STARTER HOUSING
ASSEMBLY
STARTER CLUTCH
SUB-ASSEMBLY
STEEL BALL
RETURN SPRING
STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
O-RING
STARTER BRUSH
HOLDER ASSEMBLY
O-RING
STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
9.3 (95, 82 in.*lbf)
END COVER
3.8 (39, 34 in.*lbf)
9.3 (95, 82 in.*lbf)
ST
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119850E01
ST–19
2UZ-FE STARTING – STARTER RELAY
STARTER RELAY
INSPECTION
1.
A060553
INSPECT STARTER RELAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Continuity inspection.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is
continuity between each terminal.
Specified condition
Between Terminals
Specified Condition
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5 when voltage is applied
across terminals 1 and 2.
Specified condition:
Continuity
ST
ST–20
2UZ-FE STARTING – ACC CUT RELAY
ACC CUT RELAY
INSPECTION
1.
A030519
INSPECT ACC CUT RELAY
(a) Continuity inspection.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity
between each terminal.
Specified condition
Between Terminals
Specified Condition
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity
between terminals 3 and 5 when voltage is
applied across terminals 1 and 2.
Specified condition:
Continuity
ST
2UZ-FE STARTING – IGNITION SWITCH
ST–21
IGNITION SWITCH
2UZ-FE STARTING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
STEERING COLUMN
UPPER COVER
STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER
ST
C131331E08
ST–22
2UZ-FE STARTING – IGNITION SWITCH
IGNITION OR STARTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
ST
C131333E03
2UZ-FE CHARGING – CHARGING SYSTEM
CH–3
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
(a) Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
(1) If under the lower level, replace the battery (or
add distilled water if possible) and check the
charging system.
2.
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) After having driven the vehicle and in the case that
20 minutes have not passed after having stopped
the engine, turn the ignition switch ON and turn on
the electrical system (headlight, blower motor, rear
defogger etc.) for 60 seconds to remove the surface
charge.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF and turn off the
electrical systems.
(c) Measure the battery voltage between the negative () and positive (+) terminals of the battery.
Standard voltage:
12.5 to 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
If the voltage is less than the specification, charge
the battery.
A001260
(d) Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
• Blue: OK
• White: Charging Necessary
• Red: Insufficient Water
Z011580E03
3.
CHECK BATTERY TERMINAL
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or
corroded.
4.
CHECK FUSIBLE LINK AND FUSES
(a) Check the fusible link, H-fuses and fuses for
continuity.
5.
INSPECT FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
HINT:
• If any defect has been found, replace the fan and
generator V belt.
• Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. If the belt has chunks missing from
the ribs, it should be replaced.
B000543
CH
CH–4
2UZ-FE CHARGING – CHARGING SYSTEM
(b) Check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
HINT:
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has
not slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the
pulley.
6.
VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING
(a) Check that the wiring is in good condition.
7.
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES FROM
GENERATOR
(a) Check that there is no abnormal noise from the
generator while the engine is running.
8.
INSPECT CHARGE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. Check that the charge
warning light comes on.
(b) Start the engine. Check that the light goes off.
HINT:
If the light does not operate as specified,
troubleshoot the charge warning light circuit.
9.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
(a) If a battery/generator tester is available, connect the
tester to the charging circuit as per manufacturer's
instructions.
B000540
Ammeter
Battery
Disconnected Wire
from Terminal B
Generator
Voltmeter
A073946E03
CH
(b) If a tester is not available, connect a voltmeter to the
charging circuit as follows:
(1) Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the
generator and connect it to the negative (-) lead
of the ammeter.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead of the ammeter to
terminal B of the generator.
(3) Connect the positive (+) lead of the voltmeter to
terminal B of the generator.
(4) Ground the negative (-) lead of the voltmeter.
(c) Check the charging circuit.
(1) With the engine running from idle to 2,000 rpm,
check the reading on the ammeter and
voltmeter.
Standard amperage:
10 A or less
Standard voltage:
13.2 to 14.0 V
HINT:
• If the voltmeter reading is more than
standard voltage, replace the voltage
regulator.
• If the voltmeter reading is less than the
standard voltage, check the voltage
regulator and generator.
10. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the
high beam headlights and place the heater blower
switch at "H".
2UZ-FE CHARGING – CHARGING SYSTEM
CH–5
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage:
30 A or more
HINT:
• If the ammeter reading is less than standard
amperage, repair the generator.
• If the battery is fully charged, the indication will
sometimes be less than standard amperage.
CH
CH–10
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR UPPER SUPPORT SEAL
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator upper support
seal.
3.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
4.
REMOVE FAN AND FLUID COUPLING
(a) Separate the 2 oil cooler hoses from fan shroud.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and separate the fan shroud
from radiator.
(c) Remove the 4 nuts and separate the fan w/ fluid
coupling from engine.
(d) Remove the fan shroud and fan w/ fluid coupling
from the vehicle at the same time.
5.
REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose.
(b) Remove the nut, 2 bolts and vane pump assembly.
HINT:
Hand up the hoses instead of detaching.
6.
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the generator connector.
(b) Remove the terminal cap and nut, and disconnect
the generator wire.
(c) Disconnect the alternator wire clamp from the cord
clip on the generator.
(d) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and generator.
A066671
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE GENERATOR REAR END COVER
(a) Remove the 3 nuts and end cover.
(b) Remove the terminal insulator.
2.
REMOVE GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the rear seal plate from the brush holder.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and brush holder.
(c) Remove the front seal plate from the coil assembly.
B016513
CH
B016362
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
3.
SST (A)
Turn
CH–11
REMOVE GENERATOR PULLEY
(a) Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(B) clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820-63011
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(b) Check that SST (A) is secured to the rotor shaft.
SST (B)
B016520E02
(c) Mount SST (C) in a vise.
(d) Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley
nut to SST (C).
SST (B)
Insert
SST (C)
B016524E02
(e) To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the
direction shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not
loosen the pulley nut more than one-half of a
turn.
(f) Remove the generator from SST (C).
SST (C)
SST (A)
Turn
B016373E02
(g) Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
(h) Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
Turn
SST (A)
SST (B)
B016519E02
4.
REMOVE GENERATOR COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
CH
B016364
CH–12
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
(b) Using SST, remove the coil assembly.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04020, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04071,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
(c) Remove the generator washer.
SST
5.
REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
B016366E02
INSPECTION
Ohmmeter
1.
Continuity
Continuity
INSPECT GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the rotor for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is
continuity between the slip rings.
Standard resistance:
2.3 to 2.7 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the rotor.
B012264E09
(b) Check the rotor for ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no
continuity between the slip ring and rotor.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor.
(c) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
No Continuity
B012265E08
(d) Using vernier calipers, measure the slip ring
diameter.
Standard diameter:
14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the
rotor.
B012266
2.
Length
CH
B016374E08
INSPECT GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed length:
10.5 mm (.413 in.)
Minimum exposed length:
4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
If the exposed length is less than minimum, replace
the brushes and brush holder assembly.
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
CH–13
3.
INSPECT GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Check the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
4.
INSPECT GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME
BEARING
(a) Check the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
5.
REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Remove the 4 screws, bearing retainer and bearing.
B016375
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap out the bearing.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00250), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
B016518E02
6.
INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00470), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
(b) Install the bearing retainer with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.6 N*m (27 kgf*cm, 23 in.*lbf)
7.
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME
BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and
bearing.
SST 09820-00021
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (inside).
SST
B016515E02
SST
B012270E01
CH
CH–14
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
(c) Place the bearing cover (inside) on the rotor.
B012271
8.
SST
INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820-00031
B012272E01
(b) Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285-76010
SST
B012273E01
REASSEMBLY
Pulley
1.
INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the drive end frame on the pulley.
(b) Install the rotor to the drive end frame.
2.
INSTALL GENERATOR COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the generator washer on the rotor.
B016368E01
CH
B016521
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
CH–15
(b) Using SST and a press, slowly press in the coil
assembly.
SST 09285-76010
SST
B016512E03
(c) Install the coil assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf)
B016364
3.
SST (A)
Turn
INSTALL GENERATOR PULLEY
(a) Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the
pulley nut by hand.
(b) Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(B) clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820-63011
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(c) Check that SST (A) is secured to the pulley shaft.
SST (B)
B016520E02
(d) Mount SST (C) in a vise.
(e) Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley
nut to SST (C).
SST (B)
Insert
SST (C)
B016524E02
(f)
SST (C)
To torque the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the
direction shown in the illustration.
Torque: 111 N*m (1,125 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
(g) Remove the generator from SST (C).
SST (A)
Turn
CH
B016523E02
CH–16
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
(h) Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
Turn
SST (A)
SST (B)
B016519E02
4.
INSTALL GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the front seal plate on the coil assembly.
B016363
(b) Place the brush holder on the coil assembly with the
pin facing upward.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the holder installation direction.
(c) Install the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.8 N*m (18 kgf*cm, 16 in.*lbf)
Upward
Pin
B016361E01
(d) Align the pins of the brush holder with the holes of
the rear seal plate, and install the rear seal plate.
B016360
5.
CH
B016359
INSTALL GENERATOR REAR END COVER
(a) Install the terminal insulator.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the terminal insulator installation
direction.
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
CH–17
(b) Install the end cover with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 4.6 N*m (47 kgf*cm, 41 in.*lbf)
B016513
CH
CH–18
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
INSTALLATION
CH
1.
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the generator with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: Bolt
39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
Nut (M10)
39 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
Nut (M8)
16 N*m (158 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the generator connector.
(c) Connect the generator wire with the nut and rubber
cap.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 86 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the generator wire clamp to the cord clip on
the generator.
2.
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the vane pump assembly with the nut and 2
bolts.
Torque: Nut
43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
Bolt
43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the vacuum hose.
3.
INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Put the fan w/ fluid coupling and fan shroud into the
engine room at the same time.
(b) Install the fan shroud with 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the fan w/ fluid coupling with 4 nuts.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page
EM-6)
5.
INSTALL RADIATOR UPPER SUPPORT SEAL
6.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2UZ-FE CHARGING – CHARGING SYSTEM
CH–1
CHARGING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION
(a) Check that the battery cables are connected to the
correct terminals.
(b) Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is
given a quick charge.
(c) Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation
resistance tester.
(d) Never disconnect the battery while the engine is
running.
(e) Check that the charging cable is tightened on
terminal B of the alternator and the fuse box.
(f) Do not perform inspection of the alternator
generators in which terminal F is connected to the
other terminal.
CH
CH–2
2UZ-FE CHARGING – CHARGING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
GENERATOR
CH
A119851E01
CH–6
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
GENERATOR
2UZ-FE CHARGING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RADIATOR UPPER SUPPORT SEAL
FAN AND FLUID
COUPLING
29 (296, 21)
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
CH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119815E02
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
CH–7
VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119817E02
CH
CH–8
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
9.8 (100, 86 in.*lbf)
GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
39 (400, 29)
16 (158, 11)
39 (400, 29)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A119818E02
CH
CH–9
2UZ-FE CHARGING – GENERATOR
GENERATOR WASHER
REAR BEARING
GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
BEARING RETAINER
BEARING COVER
2.6 (27, 23 in.*lbf)
FRONT BEARING
DRIVE END FRAME (STATOR)
111 (1,125, 81)
GENERATOR PULLEY
GENERATOR REAR
END COVER
TERMINAL INSULATOR
4.6 (47, 41 in.*lbf)
1.8 (18, 16 in.*lbf)
SEAL PLATE
SEAL PLATE
GENERATOR BRUSH
HOLDER ASSEMBLY
5.8 (59, 51 in.*lbf)
RECTIFIER END FRAME
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A119851E02
CH
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–17
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY (See page EM-6)
2.
REMOVE REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
3.
DISCONNECT OXYGEN SENSOR (See page AT-346)
4.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See page AT346)
5.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-14)
6.
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (See page
PR-3)
7.
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See
page AT-347)
8.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL
9.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
(See page AT-347)
10. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
LH (See page AT-347)
11. REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
12. DISCONNECT NO. 1 OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE
(See page AT-347)
13. REMOVE NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET TUBE (See page
AT-347)
14. DISCONNECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY (See page AT-348)
15. REMOVE NO. 1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET (See page AT-350)
16. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and transfer case lower
protector.
17. SUPPORT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page AT-348)
18. REMOVE NO. 3 CROSSMEMBER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page AT-348)
19. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
F043499
20. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS
21. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY (See page AT-349)
22. REMOVE MANIFOLD STAY (See page EM-79)
23. REMOVE NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY (See page EM-79)
24. SEPARATE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
25. REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page AT-350)
TF
TF–18
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
26. REMOVE TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 8 bolts and 2 clamps.
(b) Remove the transfer from the automatic
transmission.
TF
F043500
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–19
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE HOSE
2.
TEST TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and front bearing retainer subassembly.
HINT:
If necessary, tap the front bearing retainer subassembly with a plastic hammer to remove it.
3.
REMOVE TRANSFER COVER TYPE T OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the oil
seal from the front bearing retainer sub-assembly.
4.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the case cover subassembly.
5.
REMOVE BREATHER OIL DEFLECTOR SUBASSEMBLY
6.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, loosen the staked part
of the output shaft companion flange lock nut.
(b) Using SST to hold the output shaft companion
flange, remove the output shaft companion flange
lock nut.
SST 09330-00021
F043427
F043428
SST
F043429E01
(c) Using SST, remove the output shaft companion
flange sub-assembly.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04020, 09952-04010,
09953-04030, 09954-04010, 09955-04051,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
7.
REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
companion flange oil seal from the output shaft
companion flange sub-assembly.
8.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the rear output shaft companion flange
sub-assembly using the same procedure as for the
front output shaft companion flange sub-assembly.
SST 09330-00021, 09950-40011 (09951-04020,
09952-04010, 09953-04030, 09954-04010,
09955-04051, 09957-04010, 09958-04011)
SST
F043430E01
TF
TF–20
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
companion flange oil seal from the output shaft
companion flange sub-assembly.
10. REMOVE FRONT TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and extension housing subassembly.
HINT:
If necessary, tap the extension housing subassembly with a plastic hammer to remove it.
TF
F043431
11. REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
extension housing type T oil seal.
12. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT WASHER
13. REMOVE COLLAR
F043432
14. REMOVE TRANSFER REAR CASE
(a) Remove the 12 bolts and clamp.
(b) Remove the transfer rear case.
HINT:
If necessary, tap the transfer rear case with a plastic
hammer to remove it.
F043433
15. REMOVE NO. 2 TRANSFER GEAR SHIFT FORK
WITH TRANSFER HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Remove the bolt, gear shift fork No. 2 and high and
low clutch sleeve.
F043434
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–21
16. REMOVE TRANSFER SHIFT SHAFT STOPPER
(a) Remove the bolt and shift shaft stopper.
17. REMOVE TRANSFER FRONT DRIVE SHIFT FORK
SHAFT
(a) Turn the front drive shift fork shaft, and remove it
from the rear case aligning the cut out position and
the inter-lock pin position.
TF
F044750
18. REMOVE OR ROLLER SHIFT INTER-LOCK PIN
(a) Using a magnetic finger, remove the 2 shift interlock pin.
19. REMOVE NO.2 STOPPER TRANSFER SHIFT SHAFT
F043437
20. REMOVE REAR OUTPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY,
NO. 1 GEAR SHIFT FORK, FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH
SLEEVE, FRONT DRIVE CHAIN AND DRIVEN
SPROCKET
(a) Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the
shift fork shaft snap ring.
F043438
(b) Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the
snap ring.
F043439
(c) Using a snap ring expander, remove the output
shaft snap ring.
F043440
TF–22
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(d) Mount the transfer case rear in a vise.
(e) Using a plastic hammer, carefully tap the transfer
case rear and remove the rear output shaft subassembly together with gear shift fork No. 1, front
drive clutch sleeve, front drive chain and driven
sprocket sub-assembly.
TF
F043441
(f)
Remove the rear output shaft sub-assembly, gear
shift fork No. 1, front drive chain and driven sprocket
sub-assembly.
F043442
21. REMOVE NO.2 STOPPER TRANSFER SHIFT SHAFT
(a) Remove No. 2 stopper transfer shift shaft.
F043443
22. REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVEN SPROCKET BEARING
(a) Using a press, remove the driven sprocket bearing.
F043523
Steel Bar
SST
F043524E02
23. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Using SST, a press and steel bar, remove the
transfer input gear radial ball bearing.
SST 09555-55010
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–23
24. REMOVE TRANSFER SHIFT ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the
snap ring.
TF
F043444
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and transfer shift actuator
assembly.
25. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
(a) Remove the transfer case No. 1 plug (filler plug) and
gasket.
26. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
(a) Remove the transfer case No. 1 plug (drain plug)
and gasket.
F043445
27. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL SEPARATOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil separator sub-assembly.
28. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE MAGNET
F043446
29. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil pump body subassembly.
F043447
30. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY O-RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pump body Oring.
F043462
TF–24
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
31. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL PUMP GEAR
(a) Remove the transfer oil pump gear.
TF
F043448
32. REMOVE LOW PLANETARY GEAR ASSEMBLY WITH
INPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
F043449
(b) Remove the low planetary gear assembly with input
shaft assembly.
Q007221
33. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
(a) Remove the transfer output shaft spacer.
34. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
35. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
transfer case oil seal.
F043451
36. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER SHAFT
SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the input gear
stopper shaft snap ring.
F043452
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–25
37. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER
(a) Remove the transfer input gear stopper.
38. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER BALL
39. REMOVE MANUAL TRANSFER PLANETARY
CARRIER WASHER
TF
F043453
40. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
(a) Remove the transfer input shaft.
41. REMOVE TRANSFER NO. 1 THRUST BEARING
RACE
Front
42. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
F043454E01
43. REMOVE TRANSFER NO. 1 INPUT SHAFT SEAL
RING
(a) Remove the 2 seal rings.
F043525E01
44. INSPECT TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum diameter:
47.59 mm (1.8736 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the input shaft.
F043458
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter
of the input shaft bushing.
Maximum diameter:
48.14 mm (1.8953 in.)
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum,
replace the input shaft.
F043459
TF–26
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
F043465
45. INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.11 to 0.84 mm (0.0043 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
F043466
46. INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR RADIAL
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.009 to 0.038 mm (0.0004 to 0.0015 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.038 mm (0.0015 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
TF
47. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT BEARING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the input
bearing shaft snap ring.
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the input shaft
bearing.
SST 09554-30011, 09555-55010
SST
F043467E02
48. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
SPLINE PIECE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the low planetary gear spline piece.
F043507
49. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the low planetary gear bearing.
SST 09612-65014 (09612-01030, 09612-01050)
NOTICE:
Hang SST securely to the clearance between the
bearing and the low planetary gear.
SST
F043526E02
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–27
50. INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the drive sprocket
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.15 to 0.24 mm (0.0059 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.24 mm (0.0094 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket.
F044049
F044050
51. INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET RADIAL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the drive sprocket.
Standard clearance:
0.01 to 0.06 mm (0.0004 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket, output shaft rear or needle roller
bearing.
52. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
53. REMOVE NO. 2 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
SPACER
54. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
BALL
55. REMOVE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE
F044051
56. REMOVE TRANSFER CLUTCH HUB
(a) Remove the transfer clutch hub.
57. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
58. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
F043472
59. REMOVE TRANSFER SYNCHROMESH SHIFTING
KEY SPRING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 shifting key
springs.
60. REMOVE SYNCHROMESH SHIFTING KEY
TRANSFER DRIVE
(a) Remove the 3 shifting keys.
61. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
F043473
TF
TF–28
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
62. REMOVE TRANSFER SYNCHRONIZER RING SET
(a) Remove the transfer synchronizer ring.
TF
F043474
63. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR
RADIAL BALL BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the output shaft
rear radial ball bearing.
SST 09555-55010
SST
F043475E01
64. REMOVE NO. 1 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
SPACER
(a) Remove the transfer output shaft spacer.
65. REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
66. REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET BEARING
67. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
F043476
D
C
B
A
F043511E01
68. INSPECT TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the output shaft rear journal surface.
Standard diameter:
Part A:
27.98 to 27.99 mm (1.1016 to 1.1020 in.)
Part B:
31.98 to 32.00 mm (1.2591 to 1.2598 in.)
Part C:
34.98 to 35.00 mm (1.3772 to 1.3780 in.)
Part D:
36.98 to 37.00 mm (1.4559 to 1.4567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
Part A:
27.98 mm (1.1016 in.)
Part B:
31.98 mm (1.2591 in.)
Part C:
34.98 mm (1.3772 in.)
Part D:
36.98 mm (1.4559 in.)
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–29
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the output shaft rear.
F043481
F043483
69. INSPECT HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2 CLEARANCE
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
gear shift fork No. 2 claw.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
high and low clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
(c) Calculate a clearance between the high and low
clutch sleeve and gear shift fork No. 2 clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
high and low clutch sleeve or gear shift fork No. 2.
70. INSPECT FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE AND NO.
1 GEAR SHIFT FORK
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
No. 1 gear shift fork claw.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
front drive clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
(c) Calculate a clearance between the front drive clutch
sleeve and No.1 gear shift fork.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
front drive clutch sleeve or No.1 gear shift fork.
71. INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND HIGH
AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
F043493
TF
TF–30
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
72. INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND
FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
TF
F044398
73. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE PLUG
(a) Remove the transfer case plug.
74. REMOVE COMPRESSION SPRING
75. REMOVE WITH HEAD PIN
F043455
76. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
F043456
(b) Remove the low planetary ring gear from the front
case.
Front
F043457E01
INSPECTION
1.
Q007292
INSPECT TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum diameter:
47.59 mm (1.8736 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the input shaft.
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–31
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter
of the input shaft bushing.
Maximum diameter:
48.14 mm (1.8593 in.)
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum,
replace the input shaft.
TF
Q007293
2.
INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.11 to 0.84 mm (0.0043 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
3.
INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR RADIAL
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.009 to 0.038 mm (0.0004 to 00015 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.038 mm (0.0015 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
4.
INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance
of the drive sprocket.
Standard clearance:
0.15 to 0.24 mm (0.0059 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.24 mm (0.0094 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket.
5.
INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET RADIAL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the drive sprocket.
Standard clearance:
0.01 to 0.06 mm (0.0004 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket, rear output shaft or needle roller
bearing.
F043465
F043466
F044049
F044050
TF–32
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
D
C
B
6.
INSPECT TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the output shaft rear journal surface.
Standard diameter:
Part A:
27.98 to 27.99 mm (1.1016 to 1.1020 in.)
Part B:
31.98 to 32.00 mm (1.2591 to 1.2598 in.)
Part C:
34.98 to 35.00 mm (1.3772 to 1.3780 in.)
Part D:
36.98 to 37.00 mm (1.4559 to 1.4567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
Part A:
27.98 mm (1.1016 in.)
Part B:
31.98 mm (1.2591 in.)
Part C:
34.98 mm (1.3772 in.)
Part D:
36.98 mm (1.4559 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the output shaft rear.
7.
INSPECT HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2 CLEARANCE
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
gear shift fork No. 2 claw.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
high and low clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
(c) Calculate a clearance between the high and low
clutch sleeve and gear shift fork No. 2 clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
high and low clutch sleeve or gear shift fork No. 2.
8.
INSPECT FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
GEAR SHIFT FORK
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
No. 1 gear shift fork claw.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
front drive clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
A
TF
F043511E01
F043481
F043483
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–33
(c) Calculate a clearance between the front drive clutch
sleeve and No.1 gear shift fork.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
front drive clutch sleeve or No.1 gear shift fork.
9.
INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND HIGH
AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
F043493
10. INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND
FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
F044398
TF
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER SYSTEM
TF–1
TRANSFER SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
• Before disassembly, clean the transfer assembly and
remove any deposited sand and mud to prevent it from
entering the transfer during disassembly and assembly.
• When removing any light alloy parts such as the transfer
covers, do not pry them off with a tool like a screwdriver,
but tap them out with a plastic hammer.
• Always organize the removed parts properly and protect
them from dust.
• After cleaning and drying the transfer completely before
installation, apply hypoid gear oil to each part. Do not use
alkaline chemicals when cleansing aluminum or rubber
parts or ring gear set bolts. Also, do not use any cleansing
oil (ex. white gasoline) to clean rubber parts such as oil
seals.
• Apply sufficient hypoid gear oil to all sliding surfaces and
rotating parts.
• Do not directly hold any parts in a vise. Be sure to put an
aluminum sheet between them.
• Replace any damaged or deformed snap rings with new
ones.
• If the mating surface of the case is scratched, it could
cause oil leakage. Therefore, handle with care to prevent
such damage.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove old FIPG
from the seal surface.
• Clean all the components to remove the redundant FIPG
completely.
• Clean the sealing surface with solvent so that no residue
remains on the seal surface.
• Apply a line of FIPG approximately 1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
diameter of bead state along the sealing surface.
• Be sure to assemble parts within 10 minutes of application.
Otherwise, the FIPG must be removed and reapplied.
• Do not pour in oil immediately after installing sealed parts.
Leave it for at least an hour.
• Scratches on the contact surface with an oil seal or gasket
could cause oil leakage. Handle with care to prevent such
damage.
• When press-fitting an oil seal, take care to prevent the oil
seal lip and its periphery from being damaged.
• When servicing or disconnecting the 4WD ECU, be sure to
disconnect all power by removing the 20A 4WD fuse or the
negative battery terminal. Failure to disconnect power for
the 4WD ECU before performing Repair Manual diagnostic
procedures may cause the transfer case actuator to be
activated, resulting in damage to the transfer case
actuator.
TF
TF–2
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem.
The numbers indicate the ranked order of probability of each
of the possible causes.
Check each part in order.
Replace the applicable parts as necessary.
TRANSFER SYSTEM
TF
Symptom
Noise
Oil leakage
Tight corner braking
Shift from 4WD (H4) to 4WD (L4) impossible
Shift from 4WD (L4) to 4WD (H4) impossible
Shift from 2WD (H2) to 4WD (H4) impossible
Shift from 4WD (H4) to 2WD (H2) impossible
Shift from 2WD (H2) to 4WD (L4) impossible
Shift from 4WD (L4) to 2WD (H2) impossible
Suspected area
See page
1. Oil (Level low)
TF-3
2. Oil (Wrong)
TF-3
3. Transfer faulty
TF-8
1. Oil (Level too high)
TF-3
2. Gasket (Damaged)
TF-8
3. Oil seal (Worn or damaged)
TF-8
4. O-ring (Worn or damaged)
TF-8
1. Transfer faulty
TF-8
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-46
2. Differential lock switch
TF-50
3. Wire harness
TF-51
4. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-52
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-46
2. Differential lock switch
TF-50
3. Wire harness
TF-51
4. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-52
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-46
2. Wire harness
TF-51
3. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-52
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-46
2. Wire harness
TF-51
3. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-52
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-46
2. Differential lock switch
TF-50
3. Wire harness
TF-51
4. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-52
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-46
2. Differential lock switch
TF-50
3. Wire harness
TF-51
4. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-52
TF–34
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Install the low planetary ring gear to the front case.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
TF
F043456
2.
INSTALL WITH HEAD PIN
(a) Install w/ head pin.
3.
INSTALL COMPRESSION SPRING
4.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE PLUG
Torque: 18.6 N*m (190 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
(a) Install the transfer output shaft plate washer.
6.
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET BEARING
7.
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
8.
INSTALL NO. 1 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
9.
INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR RADIAL
BALL BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new output shaft
rear radial ball bearing.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00071)
NOTICE:
Install the output shaft rear radial ball bearing so
that the bearing snap ring groove face to the
rear.
F043455
F043476
SST
Rear
F044046E01
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–35
10. INSTALL TRANSFER SYNCHRONIZER RING SET
(a) Install the synchronizer ring.
TF
F043474
11. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Install front drive clutch sleeve.
F044754
12. INSTALL SYNCHROMESH SHIFTING KEY
TRANSFER DRIVE
(a) Install the3 shifting keys to the clutch hub.
13. INSTALL TRANSFER SYNCHROMESH SHIFTING
KEY SPRING
(a) Install the 2 shifting key springs to the clutch hub.
NOTICE:
Position the shifting key springs so that their
end gaps are not aligned.
F044410
14. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
(a) Install the transfer output shaft plate washer.
15. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
16. INSTALL TRANSFER CLUTCH HUB
F043472
17. INSTALL CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the center differential case.
18. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
BALL
19. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER NO.2
20. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expender, install the snap ring.
F044051
21. INSTALL DRIVE SPROCKET RADIAL CLEARANCE
TF–36
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
22. INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET THRUST CLEARANCE
23. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing with
the groove facing forward.
SST 09223-15020, 09515-30010, 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
TF
SST
F043513E01
24. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
SPLINE PIECE
(a) Using a screwdriver, install the spline piece and low
planetary gear with the snap ring.
F043507
25. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, tap in a new low planetary
gear bearing.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00570), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Press in depth:
7.7 to 8.3 mm (0.303 to 0.327 in.)
7.7 to 8.3mm
(0.303 to 0.327 in.)
SST
Q007440E01
26. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT BEARING SHAFT SNAP
RING
(a) Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial
play.
F043468
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
1
1.45 to 1.50 (0.0571 to 0.0591)
2
1.50 to 1.55 (0.0591 to 0.0610)
3
1.55 to 1.60 (0.0610 to 0.0630)
4
1.60 to 1.65 (0.0630 to 0.0650)
5
1.65 to 1.70 (0.0650 to 0.0669)
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
TF–37
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
27. INSTALL TRANSFER NO. 1 INPUT SHAFT SEAL
RING
(a) Apply gear oil to the oil seal ring.
(b) Engage securely to eliminate clearance as shown in
the illustration.
TF
F043460
28. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
(a) Install the transfer low planetary gear bearing.
Front
29. INSTALL NO. 1 TRANSFER THRUST BEARING RACE
30. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
F043454E01
31. INSTALL MANUAL TRANSFER PLANETARY
CARRIER WASHER
(a) Install the manual transfer planetary carrier washer.
32. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER BALL
33. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER
F043453
34. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER SHAFT
SNAP RING
(a) Select an input gear stopper shaft snap ring that
allows 0.05 to 0.15 mm (0.0020 to 0.0059 in.) axial
play.
F043514
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
A
2.10 to 2.15 (0.0827 to 0.0846)
B
2.15 to 2.20 (0.0846 to 0.0866)
C
2.20 to 2.25 (0.0866 to 0.0886)
D
2.25 to 2.30 (0.0886 to 0.0906)
E
2.30 to 2.35 (0.0906 to 0.0925)
F
2.35 to 2.40 (0.0925 to 0.0945)
G
2.40 to 2.45 (0.0945 to 0.0965)
H
2.45 to 2.50 (0.0965 to 0.0984)
J
2.50 to 2.55 (0.0984 to 0.1004)
K
2.55 to 2.60 (0.1004 to 0.1024)
L
2.60 to 2.65 (0.1024 to 0.1043)
M
2.65 to 2.70 (0.1043 to 0.1063)
N
2.70 to 2.75 (0.1063 to 0.1083)
P
2.75 to 2.80 (0.1083 to 0.1102)
TF–38
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Q
2.80 to 2.85 (0.1102 to 0.1122)
R
2.85 to 2.90 (0.1122 to 0.1142)
S
2.90 to 2.95 (0.1142 to 0.1161)
T
2.95 to 3.00 (0.1161 to 0.1181)
U
3.00 to 3.05 (0.1181 to 0.1201)
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the new input
gear stopper shaft snap ring.
TF
Q007289
35. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the case upper surface.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011)
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
F043515E01
36. INSTALL LOW PLANETARY GEAR ASSEMBLY WITH
INPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the low planetary gear assembly with input
shaft sub-assembly.
F043450
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the shaft snap
ring.
F043449
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–39
37. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL PUMP GEAR
(a) Install transfer oil pump gear.
TF
F043448
38. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY O-RING
(a) Coat a new O-ring with gear oil and install it to the
oil pump body.
F043463E01
39. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the oil pump body sub-assembly with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
40. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE MAGNET
F043447
41. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL SEPARATOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the oil separator sub-assembly with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
42. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE PLUG
(a) Install the case plug No. 1 (filler plug) and a new
gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (380 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
F043446
43. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE PLUG
(a) Install the case plug (drain plug) and a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (380 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
TF–40
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
44. INSTALL TRANSFER SHIFT ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the shift actuator assembly with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive in the snap
ring.
TF
F043445
45. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new input gear
radial ball bearing.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00031)
SST
F043464E02
46. INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVEN SPROCKET BEARING
(a) Using a press, install a new driven sprocket bearing.
F044041
47. INSTALL NO.2 STOPPER TRANSFER SHIFT SHAFT
(a) Install No. 2 stopper transfer shift shaft.
F043443
48. INSTALL REAR OUTPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY,
NO. 1 GEAR SHIFT FORK, FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH
SLEEVE, FRONT DRIVE CHAIN AND DRIVEN
SPROCKET
(a) Install the rear output shaft sub-assembly, gear shift
fork No. 1 and drive sprocket to the front drive chain.
F043442
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–41
(b) Install the rear output shaft sub-assembly, gear shift
fork No. 1, front drive clutch sleeve, front drive chain
and driven sprocket sub-assembly to the case rear.
HINT:
Check that the rear output shaft sub-assembly and
driven sprocket sub-assembly turn lightly.
TF
F043441
(c) Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
F043440
(d) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive in the snap
ring.
F044399
(e) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive in the snap
ring.
F044400
49. INSTALL NO.2 STOPPER TRANSFER SHIFT SHAFT
(a) Install No. 2 stopper transfer shift shaft.
50. INSTALL OR ROLLER SHIFT INTER-LOCK PIN
F043437
TF–42
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
51. INSTALL TRANSFER FRONT DRIVE SHIFT FORK
SHAFT
(a) Turn the front drive shift fork shaft, and install it on
the rear case aligning the cut out position and the
inter-lock pin position.
52. INSTALL TRANSFER SHIFT SHAFT STOPPER
(a) Install the shift shaft stopper with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N*m (195 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
TF
F043436
53. INSTALL TRANSFER GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2 WITH
TRANSFER HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Install the gear shift fork No. 2 and high and low
clutch sleeve.
(b) Install the bolt.
Torque: 24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
Front
54. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
F044401E01
FIPG
55. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
56. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE REAR
(a) Apply FIPG to the case rear, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
F043488E01
(b) Install the clamp and case rear with the 12 bolts.
Torque: 28 N*m (285 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
F043433
57. INSTALL COLLAR
(a) Install collar.
58. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT WASHER
F043432
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–43
59. INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal
until its surface is flush with the housing upper
surface.
SST 09223-46011, 09631-32020
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
TF
F043516E02
FIPG
F043489E01
60. INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING SUBASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Apply FIPG to the extension housing sub-assembly,
as shown in the illustration.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
(b) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(c) Install the extension housing sub-assembly with the
5 bolts.
Torque: 12 N*m (122 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
F043431
61. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal
(front side).
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00320), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
F043517E02
62. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Drive in a new output shaft companion flange oil
seal using the same procedure as for the oil seal.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00320), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
TF–44
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
Front:
63. INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the companion flange sub-assembly (front
side) onto the drive sprocket sub-assembly.
(b) Using SST to hold the companion flange, install a
new companion flange lock nut.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 118 N*m (1,200 kgf*cm, 87 ft.*lbf)
(c) Using a chisel and hammer, stake the companion
flange lock nut.
Rear:
TF
64. INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, install the companion flange subassembly using the same procedure as for the
companion flange sub-assembly (rear side).
Torque: 118 N*m (1,200 kgf*cm, 87 ft.*lbf)
SST 09330-00021
SST
65. INSTALL BREATHER OIL DEFLECTOR
F044048E02
66. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the case cover sub-assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
F043428
67. INSTALL TRANSFER COVER TYPE T OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal
until its surface is flush with the retainer upper
surface.
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00590), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
F043518E02
FIPG
F043490E01
68. INSTALL TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Apply FIPG to the front bearing retainer subassembly, as shown in the illustration.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
(b) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–45
(c) Install the front bearing retainer sub-assembly with
the 5 bolts.
Torque: 11.5 N*m (117 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
69. INSTALL HOSES
TF
F043427
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the transfer assembly with the 8 bolts.
Torque: 24 N*m (240 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the adaptor rear oil seal
with the transfer input gear spline.
2.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page AT-352)
3.
CONFIRM FRONT DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
4.
INSTALL MANIFOLD STAY NO.2 (See page EM-92)
5.
INSTALL MANIFOLD STAY (See page EM-92)
6.
INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY (See page AT-353)
7.
CONNECT WIRE HARNESS
8.
CONNECT CONNECTOR
9.
INSTALL NO. 3 FRAME CROSSMEMBER SUBASSEMBLY (See page AT-354)
F043500
10. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(a) Install the transfer case lower protector with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
11. INSTALL NO. 1 TRANSFER CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET (See page AT-352)
12. CONNECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY (See page AT-354)
F043499
13. INSTALL NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET TUBE (See page
AT-354)
14. CONNECT NO. 1 OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE (See
page AT-354)
15. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
16. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
LH (See page AT-355)
17. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
(See page AT-355)
18. ADD TRANSFER OIL
TF–46
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
19. ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See page
AT-355)
20. INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See
page AT-355)
21. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (See page
PR-6)
TF
22. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
(See page PR-19)
23. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See page AT355)
24. CONNECT OXYGEN SENSOR (See page AT-355)
25. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(See page AT-355)
26. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY (See page AT-355)
27. INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See
page AT-355)
28. INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION (See page AT-355)
29. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
30. WARM UP
31. DRIVE TEST
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER OIL
0 to 5 mm
(0 to 0.20 in.)
TF–3
TRANSFER OIL
ADJUSTMENT
1.
C083746E02
2.
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL
(a) Remove the filler plug and gasket.
(b) Check that the oil level is within 5 mm (0.20 in.) of
the bottom of the filler plug hole.
NOTICE:
• When replacing the oil, recheck the oil level
after driving.
• Excessively large or small quantities of oil
may cause troubles.
(c) When the oil level is too low, check for oil leakage.
(d) Tighten the filler plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
ADJUST TRANSFER OIL
(a) Remove the filler plug and gasket then supply oil.
NOTICE:
• When supplying oil, pour slowly.
• Pour the oil in several stages allowing several
minutes between each step.
HINT:
The oil level should be within 5 mm (0.20 in.) of the
bottom of the oil filler plug hole.
(b) After leaving it alone for 5 minutes, check the oil
level again.
(c) Tighten the filler plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
TF
TF–4
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
DRIVE LINE
VF4AM
TRANSFER
COMPONENTS
TF
18 (185, 13)
18.6 (190, 14)
CASE PLUG
CASE COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
COMPRESSION SPRING
BREATHER OIL
DEFLECTOR
HEAD PIN
SNAP RING
*
11.5 (117, 8)
x5
SNAP RING
OIL SEAL
FRONT BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER FRONT CASE
OIL SEAL
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
118 (1,200, 87)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
* Precoated part
C131342E03
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
TF–5
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL
2.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-17)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER
HINT:
(See page AT-346)
4.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-18)
5.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
case.
SST
F043485E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Coat the lip of a new oil seal with MP grease.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the case upper surface.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011)
2.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-43)
3.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER
HINT:
(See page AT-351)
4.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-44)
5.
ADD TRANSFER OIL (See page TF-3)
6.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See page
AT-355)
7.
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See
page AT-355)
8.
WARMING UP
9.
DRIVE TEST
SST
F043487E02
TF
TF–6
VF4AM TRANSFER – EXTENSION HOUSING OIL SEAL
EXTENSION HOUSING OIL SEAL
DRIVE LINE
VF4AM
TRANSFER
COMPONENTS
TF
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER EXTENSION
HOUSING TYPE T OIL SEAL
C139738E02
VF4AM TRANSFER – EXTENSION HOUSING OIL SEAL
TF–7
REMOVAL
SST
1.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL
2.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-17)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page TF-5)
4.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-18)
5.
REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
extension housing sub-assembly rear.
F043484E02
INSTALLATION
SST
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Coat the lip of a new oil seal with MP grease.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the housing upper surface.
SST 09223-46011, 09631-32020
2.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-43)
3.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page TF-5)
4.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-44)
5.
ADD TRANSFER OIL (See page TF-3)
6.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See page
AT-355)
7.
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See
page AT-355)
8.
WARMING UP
9.
DRIVE TEST
F043486E02
TF
TF–8
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
DRIVE LINE
VF4AM
TRANSFER
COMPONENTS
TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER
TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
TF
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
ATF LEVEL GAUGE
88 (900, 65)
88 (900, 65)
12 (120, 9)
O-RING
5 (50, 43 in.*lbf)
OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO. 1 AND
OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO. 1
24 (240, 17)
x5
34 (346, 25)
TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
18 (184, 13)
24 (240, 17)
48 (490, 35)
TRANSFER CASE
LOWER PROTECTOR
25 (255, 18)
x6
x3
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CABLE ASSEMBLY
71 (720, 53)
12 (120, 9)
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO. 1
88 (900, 65)
PROPELLER SHAFT
ASSEMBLY FRONT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
88 (900, 65)
Non-reusable part
C131340E02
TF–9
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
MANIFOLD STAY
GASKET
EXHAUST PIPE
ASSEMBLY
STARTER ASSEMBLY
40 (408, 30)
40 (490, 35)
GASKET
GASKET
62 (630, 46)
MANIFOLD STAY NO.2
40 (408, 30)
EXHAUST PIPE
ASSEMBLY
GASKET
62 (630, 46)
NO. 3 FRAME CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR REAR NO. 1
65 (663, 48)
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET
72 (734, 53)
18 (184, 13)
33 (336, 24)
33 (336, 24)
REAR ENGINE UNDER
COVER ASSEMBLY
FRONT SUSPENSION
MEMBER BRACKET LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131341E02
TF
TF–10
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
18 (185, 13)
18.6 (190, 14)
TF
CASE PLUG
CASE COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
SNAP RING
COMPRESSION SPRING
BREATHER OIL
DEFLECTOR
WITH HEAD PIN
SNAP RING
*
LOW PLANETARY
RING GEAR
11.5 (117, 8)
x5
TRANSFER FRONT CASE
OIL SEAL
FRONT BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
118 (1,200, 87)
OIL SEAL
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
* Precoated part
C131342E04
TF–11
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
SPACER
INPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
BALL
LOW PLANTARY GEAR ASSEMBLY
OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
PLANETARU
CARR WASHER
THRUST BEARING RACE NO. 1
LOW PLANETARY GEAR BEARING
INPUT GEAR STOPPER
7.8 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
SNAP RING
O-RING
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
OIL SEPARATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER CASE MAGNET
OIL PUMP GEAR
7.8 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
OIL PUMP BODY SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131343E02
TF
TF–12
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
20 (200, 14)
SNAP RING
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 1
TF
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2
SNAP RING
x12
REAR OUTPUT SHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
24 (245, 18)
28 (285, 21)
NO. 2 STOPPER SHIFT SHAFT
CLAMP
GASKET
37 (380, 27)
NO. 1 PLUG
(DRAIN PLUG)
37 (380, 27)
NO. 1 PLUG
(DRAIN PLUG)
HIGH AND LOW
CLUTCH SLEEVE
ROLLER SHIFT
INTER-LOCK PIN
GASKET
FRONT DRIVE CHAIN
TRANSFER CASE REAR
DRIVEN SPROCKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 STOPPER
SHIFT SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHIFT
FORK SHAFT
SHIFT SHAFT STOPPER
19 (195, 14)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131344E02
TF–13
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF
118 (1,200, 87)
*
12 (120, 9)
x5
EXTENSION HOUSING
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
OIL SEAL
SNAP RING
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL
COLLAR
OUTPUT WASHER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
* Precoated part
C131345E02
TF–14
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
INPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY:
SEAL RING NO. 1
TF
TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
Non-reusable part
C131346E02
DRIVEN SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY:
TRANSFER DRIVEN
SPROCKET BEARING
TRANSFER INPUT GEAR
RADIAL BALL BEARING
TRANSFER DRIVEN SPROCKET
Non-reusable part
C131347E02
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–15
LOW PLANETARY GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY:
TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT BEARING
SNAP RING
TF
LOW PLANETARY GEAR
TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY
GEAR SPLINE PIECE
SNAP RING
TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY
GEAR BEARING
Non-reusable part
C131348E02
TF–16
VF4AM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
REAR OUTPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY:
TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
REAR RADIAL BALL BEARING
TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
DRIVE SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER DRIVE
SPROCKET BEARING
TF
OUTPUT SHAFT
PLATE WASHER
TRANSFER OUTPUT
SHAFT REAR
OUTPUT SHAFT
PLATE WASHER
TRANSFER SYNCHRONIZER
RING SET
FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
TRANSFER SYNCHROMESH
SHIFTING KEY SPRING
OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
SYNCHROMESH
SHIFTING KEY
CLUTCH HUB
CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE
TRANSFER OUTPUT
SHAFT SPACER BALL
SNAP RING
TRANSFER OUTPUT
SHAFT SPACER NO.2
Non-reusable part
C131349E03
TF–46
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
DRIVE LINE
VF4AM
TRANSFER
PARTS LOCATION
TF
FOUR WHEEL DRIVE
CONTROL SWITCH
FOUR WHEEL DRIVE
CONTROL ECU
DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SWITCH
TRANSFER SHIFT
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
C131359E03
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
TF–47
INSPECTION
NOTICE:
• H4 to L4: Stop the vehicle and apply brake, then shift
the transmission shift lever into "N" position first.
• Do not operate the four wheel drive control switch and
the differential lock switch at the same time.
• Do not change from 2WD to 4WD when the vehicle
speed is 100 km/h or more.
1.
INSPECT H2 (2WD) TO H4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL
LOCK "FREE") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and the differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H2" position to the "H4" position.
(c) Check that the 4WD indicator light comes on after it
is blinking. (The center diff. lock indicator blinks
while shifting.)
(d) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "H2" position. (The center diff.
lock indicator blinks while shifting.)
(e) Check that the 4WD indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
2.
INSPECT H4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"LOCK") TO H2 (2WD) SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds.
(c) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "H2" position.
(d) Check that the 4WD indicator light and center diff.
lock indicator light goes off after those are blinking.
F044403
F044404
TF
TF–48
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
3.
INSPECT H4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"FREE") TO H4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and the differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch to "H4"
position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds. Check that the center diff. lock indicator
light goes off after pressing the differential lock
switch for 2 seconds.
4.
INSPECT L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"FREE") TO L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch to "L4"
position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
(d) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds. Check that the center diff. lock indicator
light goes off after pressing the differential lock
switch for 2 seconds.
5.
INSPECT H4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"FREE") TO L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"FREE") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "L4" position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
(d) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"L4" position to the "H4" position while pressing it.
(e) Check that the 4LO indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
TF
F044034
F044035
F044036
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
6.
F044037
TF–49
INSPECT H4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"LOCK") TO L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds.
(c) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "L4" position while pressing it.
(d) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
(e) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"L4" position to the "H4" position while pressing it.
(f) Check that the 4LO indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
7.
INSPECT H2 (2WD) TO L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL
LOCK "FREE") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H2" position to the "H4" position.
(c) Check that the 4WD indicator light comes on after it
is blinking. (The center diff. lock indicator blinks
while shifting.)
(d) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "L4" position while pressing it.
(e) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
8.
INSPECT L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"FREE") TO H2 (2WD) SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"L4" position to the "H4" position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the 4LO indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
(d) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "H2" position.
(e) Check that the 4WD indicator light goes off after it is
blinking. (The center diff. lock indicator blinks while
shifting.)
F044405
F044406
TF
TF–50
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
9.
TF
INSPECT L4 (4WD AND DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
"LOCK") TO H2 (2WD) SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds.
(c) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"L4" position to the "H4" position while pressing it.
(d) Check that the 4LO indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
(e) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "H2" position.
(f) Check that the 4WD indicator light and center diff.
lock indicator light goes off after those are blinking.
F044407
10. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SWITCH
(a) Remove the instrument panel finish lower panel
sub-assembly.
(b) Remove the differential lock switch from the
instrument panel finish lower sub-assembly.
(c) Inspect the continuity between the each terminal.
OFF
ON
GND
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
+B (3) to GND (4)
No continuity
Hold ON
+B (3) to GND (4)
Continuity
Illumination
ILL+ (1) to ILL- (2)
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the
differential lock switch or bulb.
ILL-
+B
Switch position
ILL+
F044040E01
TF–51
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
GND
2-4
11. INSPECT FOUR WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Remove the center instrument cluster finish panel
sub-assembly.
(b) Remove the four wheel drive control switch from the
center instrument cluster finish panel sub-assembly.
(c) Inspect the continuity between the each terminals.
LO
ILL-
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
H2
2-4 (5) to GND (4)
Continuity
2-4 (5) to GND (4)
Continuity
2-4 (5) to GND (4)
No continuity
ILL+
F044039E03
H4
LO (2) to GND (4)
Continuity
LO (2) to GND (4)
No continuity
L4
LO (2) to GND (4)
Continuity
Illumination
ILL+ (1) to ILL- (3)
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the four
wheel drive control switch or bulb.
12. INSPECT ACTUATOR
NOTICE:
Inspection for the actuator must be done with the
actuator installed on the transfer assembly.
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(b) Check the operating sound produced by four wheel
drive control switch operation and the differential
lock switch operation.
If the operating sound cannot be heard, check the
four wheel control ECU and the wire harness in the
next step. When the wire harness and four wheel
drive control ECU is normal, replace the actuator.
Four Wheel Drive Control ECU Connector
F10
Transfer Shift Actuator Connector
T3
F044038E01
13. INSPECT WIRE HARNESS
(a) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal or remove the 20A 4WD fuse.
CAUTION:
Failure to disconnect power for the 4WD ECU
may cause the transfer case actuator to be
activated, resulting in damage to the transfer
case actuator.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector and four wheel
drive control ECU connector.
(c) Check continuity on the wire harness between four
wheel drive control ECU and the actuator.
Tester connection
Specified condition
TM1 (F10-2) - TM1 (T3-2)
Continuity
TM2 (F10-5) - TM2 (T3-1)
Continuity
TL2 (F10-24) - TL2 (T3-4)
Continuity
TL3 (F10-23) - TL3 (T3-5)
Continuity
HM2 (F10-4) - HM2 (T3-7)
Continuity
HM1 (F10-1) - HM1 (T3-8)
Continuity
P1 (F10-22) - CDL (T3-9)
Continuity
HL2 (F10-26) - HL2 (T3-11)
Continuity
HL1 (F10-17) - HL1 (T3-12)
Continuity
TF
TF–52
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
If continuity is not as specified, repair or replace the
wire harness.
14. INSPECT FOUR WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL ECU
(a) Connect the wire harness side connector to the four
wheel drive control ECU.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal
or install the 20A 4WD fuse.
(c) Inspect the wire harness side connector from the
back side, as shown below.
TF
F9
F10
C134067E01
STANDARD VALUE OF ECU TERMINAL
Terminals (Symbols)
Condition
F10-1 (HM1) - F10-4 (HM2)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
F10-4 (HM2) - F10-1 (HM1)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "L4" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "H4" position
•
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "H4" position
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Keep pressing the differential lock switch approx. 2 seconds
to turn it ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4" position or "L4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position
F10-2 (TM1) - F10-5 (TM2)
F10-5 (TM2) - F10-2 (TM1)
•
STD Voltage (V)
10 - 14 to 2 or less
or
0 (0.5 s) - 14 (50 ms)
pulse generation
10 - 14 to 2 or less
or
0 (0.5 s) - 14 (50 ms)
pulse generation
F10-3 (DM1) - F10-6 (DM2)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
A.D.D. FREE → A.D.D. LOCK
F10-6 (DM2) - F10-3 (DM1)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
A.D.D. LOCK → A.D.D. FREE
F10-4 (HM2) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
F9-1 (GND) - Body ground
•
Ignition switch OFF
Continuity
10 - 14
10 - 14 to 2 or less
or
0 (0.5 s) - 14 (50 ms)
pulse generation
2 or less to 10 - 14
F9-6 (IG) - F9-1 (GND)
•
Ignition switch ON
F10-12 (DL2) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
A.D.D. LOCK → A.D.D. FREE
2 or less to 10 - 14
F10-13 (DL1) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
A.D.D. FREE → A.D.D. LOCK
2 or less to 10 - 14
F10-17 (HL1) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
10 - 14 to 2 or less
F9-8 (2-4) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "L4" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "H22" position or "H4" position
10 - 14 to 2 or less
F9-9 (SPD) - F9-1 (GND)
•
During driving
Pulse generation
VF4AM TRANSFER – TOUCH SELECT 2-4 AND HIGH-LOW SYSTEM
Terminals (Symbols)
Condition
TF–53
STD Voltage (V)
F9-11 (IND3) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
10 - 14 to 0 - 3.5
F9-15 (LO) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
10 - 14 to 2 or less
F9-16 (DL) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position → Keep pressing
the differential lock switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
10 - 14 to 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
A.D.D. FREE → A.D.D. LOCK
10 - 14 to 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position → Keep pressing
the differential lock switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
2 or less to 10 - 14
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position → Keep pressing
the differential lock switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
10 - 14 to 2 or less
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position → "ON" position
2 or less to 10 - 14
F10-18 (ADD) - F9-1 (GND)
F10-23 (TL3) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
•
F10-24 (TL2) - F9-1 (GND)
•
F10-25 (TL1) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
•
F10-26 (HL2) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
2 or less to 10 - 14
F9-19 (IND1) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H2" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "H4" position or "L4" position
10 - 14 to 2 or less
F9-20 (IND2) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position → Keep pressing
the differential lock switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
10 - 14 to 2 or less
F9-22 (N) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Transmission shift lever other position → Transmission shift
lever N position
2 or less to 10 - 14
F9-24 (L4) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4" position → Four wheel
drive control switch "L4" position
10 - 14 to 2 or less
TF
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–17
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY (See page CO-13)
2.
REMOVE REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
3.
DISCONNECT OXYGEN SENSOR (See page AT-359)
4.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See page AT359)
5.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-14)
6.
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (See page
PR-3)
7.
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See
page AT-359)
8.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL
9.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
(See page AT-347)
10. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
LH (See page AT-359)
11. REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
12. DISCONNECT NO. 1 OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE
(See page AT-359)
13. REMOVE NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET TUBE (See page
AT-359)
14. DISCONNECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY (See page AT-360)
15. REMOVE NO. 1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET (See page AT-360)
16. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and transfer case lower
protector.
17. SUPPORT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page AT-360)
18. REMOVE NO. 3 CROSSMEMBER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page AT-360)
19. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
F043499
20. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS
21. REMOVE FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER (See
page AT-360)
22. REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page AT-361)
TF
TF–18
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
23. REMOVE TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 8 bolts and 2 clamps.
(b) Remove the transfer from the automatic
transmission.
TF
F043500
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–19
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE HOSE
2.
TEST TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and front bearing retainer subassembly.
HINT:
If necessary, tap the front bearing retainer subassembly with a plastic hammer to remove it.
3.
REMOVE TRANSFER COVER TYPE T OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the oil
seal from the front bearing retainer sub-assembly.
4.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the case cover subassembly.
5.
REMOVE BREATHER OIL DEFLECTOR SUBASSEMBLY
6.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, loosen the staked part
of the output shaft companion flange lock nut.
(b) Using SST to hold the output shaft companion
flange, remove the output shaft companion flange
lock nut.
SST 09330-00021
F043427
F043428
SST
F043429E01
(c) Using SST, remove the output shaft companion
flange sub-assembly.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04020, 09952-04010,
09953-04030, 09954-04010, 09955-04051,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
7.
REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
companion flange oil seal from the output shaft
companion flange sub-assembly.
8.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the rear output shaft companion flange
sub-assembly using the same procedure as for the
front output shaft companion flange sub-assembly.
SST 09330-00021, 09950-40011 (09951-04020,
09952-04010, 09953-04030, 09954-04010,
09955-04051, 09957-04010, 09958-04011)
SST
F043430E01
TF
TF–20
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
companion flange oil seal from the output shaft
companion flange sub-assembly.
10. REMOVE FRONT TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and extension housing subassembly.
HINT:
If necessary, tap the extension housing subassembly with a plastic hammer to remove it.
TF
F043431
11. REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
extension housing type T oil seal.
12. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT WASHER
13. REMOVE COLLAR
F043432
14. REMOVE TRANSFER REAR CASE
(a) Remove the 12 bolts and clamp.
(b) Remove the transfer rear case.
HINT:
If necessary, tap the transfer rear case with a plastic
hammer to remove it.
F043433
15. REMOVE NO. 2 TRANSFER GEAR SHIFT FORK
WITH TRANSFER HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Remove the bolt, gear shift fork No. 2 and high and
low clutch sleeve.
F043434
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–21
16. REMOVE CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK FORK SUBASSEMBLY WITH FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Using 2 screwdrivers and hammer, tap out the snap
ring.
TF
F043502
(b) Remove the bolt, CTR differential lock fork subassembly and front drive clutch sleeve.
F043503
17. REMOVE REAR OUTPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY,
FRONT DRIVE CHAIN AND DRIVEN SPROCKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Mount the transfer case rear in a vise.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, carefully tap the a transfer
case rear, and remove the rear output shaft sub
assembly together with front drive chain and driven
sprocket sub-assembly.
F043504
(c) Remove the rear output shaft sub-assembly, front
drive chain and driven sprocket sub assembly.
F043505
18. REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVEN SPROCKET BEARING
(a) Using a press, remove the driven sprocket bearing.
F043523
TF–22
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
19. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Using SST, a press and steel bar, remove the
transfer input gear radial ball bearing.
SST 09555-55010
Steel Bar
SST
TF
F043524E02
20. REMOVE TRANSFER SHIFT ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the 2
snap rings.
F043506
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and transfer shift actuator
assembly.
21. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
(a) Remove the transfer case No. 1 plug (filler plug) and
gasket.
22. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
(a) Remove the transfer case No. 1 plug (drain plug)
and gasket.
F043445
23. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL SEPARATOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil separator sub-assembly.
24. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE MAGNET
F043446
25. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil pump body subassembly.
F043447
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–23
26. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY O-RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pump body Oring.
TF
F043462
27. REMOVE TRANSFER OIL PUMP GEAR
(a) Remove the transfer oil pump gear.
F043448
28. REMOVE LOW PLANETARY GEAR ASSEMBLY WITH
INPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
F043449
(b) Remove the low planetary gear assembly with input
shaft assembly.
Q007221
29. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
(a) Remove the transfer output shaft spacer.
30. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
31. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
transfer case oil seal.
F043451
TF–24
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
32. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER SHAFT
SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the input gear
stopper shaft snap ring.
TF
F043452
33. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER
(a) Remove the transfer input gear stopper.
34. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER BALL
35. REMOVE MANUAL TRANSFER PLANETARY
CARRIER WASHER
F043453
36. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
(a) Remove the transfer input shaft.
37. REMOVE TRANSFER NO. 1 THRUST BEARING
RACE
Front
38. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
F043454E01
39. REMOVE TRANSFER NO. 1 INPUT SHAFT SEAL
RING
(a) Remove the 2 seal rings.
F043525E01
40. INSPECT TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum diameter:
47.59 mm (1.8736 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the input shaft.
F043458
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–25
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter
of the input shaft bushing.
Maximum diameter:
48.14 mm (1.8953 in.)
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum,
replace the input shaft.
TF
F043459
F043465
41. INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.11 to 0.84 mm (0.0043 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
F043466
42. INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR RADIAL
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.009 to 0.038 mm (0.0004 to 0.0015 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.038 mm (0.0015 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
43. REMOVE TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT BEARING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the input shaft
bearing.
SST 09554-30011, 09555-55010
SST
F043467E02
44. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
SPLINE PIECE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the low planetary gear spline piece.
F043507
TF–26
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
45. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the low planetary gear bearing.
SST 09612-65014 (09612-01030, 09612-01050)
NOTICE:
Hang SST securely to the clearance between the
bearing and the low planetary gear.
SST
TF
F043526E02
46. INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the drive sprocket
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.15 to 0.24 mm (0.0059 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.24 mm (0.0094 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket.
F044049
F044050
47. INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET RADIAL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the drive sprocket.
Standard clearance:
0.01 to 0.06 mm (0.0004 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket, output shaft rear or needle roller
bearing.
48. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
49. REMOVE NO. 2 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
SPACER
50. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
BALL
51. REMOVE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE
F044051
52. REMOVE TRANSFER CLUTCH HUB
(a) Remove the transfer clutch hub.
53. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
54. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
F043510
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–27
55. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR
RADIAL BALL BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the output shaft
rear radial ball bearing.
SST 09555-55010
SST
TF
F043475E01
56. REMOVE NO. 1 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
SPACER
(a) Remove the transfer output shaft spacer.
57. REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
58. REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET BEARING
59. REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
F043476
D
C
B
A
F043511E01
60. INSPECT TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the output shaft rear journal surface.
Standard diameter:
Part A:
27.98 to 27.99 mm (1.1016 to 1.1020 in.)
Part B:
31.98 to 32.00 mm (1.2591 to 1.2598 in.)
Part C:
34.98 to 35.00 mm (1.3772 to 1.3780 in.)
Part D:
36.98 to 37.00 mm (1.4559 to 1.4567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
Part A:
27.98 mm (1.1016 in.)
Part B:
31.98 mm (1.2591 in.)
Part C:
34.98 mm (1.3772 in.)
Part D:
36.98 mm (1.4559 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the output shaft rear.
TF–28
TF
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
F043481
F043483
61. INSPECT HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2 CLEARANCE
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
gear shift fork No. 2 claw.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
high and low clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
(c) Calculate a clearance between the high and low
clutch sleeve and gear shift fork No. 2 clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
high and low clutch sleeve or gear shift fork No. 2.
62. INSPECT FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE AND CTR
DIFFERENTIAL LOCK FORK SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLEARANCE
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
CTR differential lock fork clow.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
front drive clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
(c) Calculate a clearance between the front drive clutch
sleeve and CTR differential lock fork.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
front drive clutch sleeve or CTR differential lock fork.
63. INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND HIGH
AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
F043493
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–29
64. INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND
FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
TF
F044398
65. REMOVE TRANSFER CASE PLUG
(a) Remove the transfer case plug.
66. REMOVE COMPRESSION SPRING
67. REMOVE WITH HEAD PIN
F043455
68. REMOVE TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
F043456
(b) Remove the low planetary ring gear from the front
case.
Front
F043457E01
INSPECTION
1.
F043458
INSPECT TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum diameter:
47.59 mm (1.8736 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the input shaft.
TF–30
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter
of the input shaft bushing.
Maximum diameter:
48.14 mm (1.8593 in.)
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum,
replace the input shaft.
TF
Q007293
2.
INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.11 to 0.84 mm (0.0043 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
3.
INSPECT PLANETARY PINION GEAR RADIAL
CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard clearance:
0.009 to 0.038 mm (0.0004 to 00015 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.038 mm (0.0015 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
4.
INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance
of the drive sprocket.
Standard clearance:
0.15 to 0.24 mm (0.0059 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.24 mm (0.0094 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket.
5.
INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET RADIAL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance
of the drive sprocket.
Standard clearance:
0.01 to 0.06 mm (0.0004 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
drive sprocket, rear output shaft or needle roller
bearing.
F043465
F043466
F044049
F044050
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
6.
D
C
B
A
F043511E01
INSPECT TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of
the output shaft rear journal surface.
Standard diameter:
Part A:
27.98 to 27.99 mm (1.1016 to 1.1020 in.)
Part B:
31.98 to 32.00 mm (1.2591 to 1.2598 in.)
Part C:
34.98 to 35.00 mm (1.3772 to 1.3780 in.)
Part D:
36.98 to 37.00 mm (1.4559 to 1.4567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
Part A:
27.98 mm (1.1016 in.)
Part B:
31.98 mm (1.2591 in.)
Part C:
34.98 mm (1.3772 in.)
Part D:
36.98 mm (1.4559 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum,
replace the output shaft rear.
7.
INSPECT HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2 CLEARANCE
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
gear shift fork No. 2 claw.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
high and low clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
(c) Calculate a clearance between the high and low
clutch sleeve and gear shift fork No. 2 clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
high and low clutch sleeve or gear shift fork No. 2.
8.
INSPECT FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE AND CTR
DIFFERENTIAL LOCK FORK SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLEARANCE
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of the
CTR differential lock fork clow.
Thickness:
10 mm (0.3937 in.)
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the groove of the
front drive clutch sleeve.
Distance:
10.5 mm (0.4134 in.)
F043481
F043483
TF–31
TF
TF–32
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(c) Calculate a clearance between the front drive clutch
sleeve and CTR differential lock fork.
Standard clearance:
0.26 to 0.84 mm (0.0102 to 0.0331 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.84 mm (0.0331 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
front drive clutch sleeve or CTR differential lock fork.
9.
TF
INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND HIGH
AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
F043493
10. INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND
FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Check that the tip of the spline gear of the front drive
clutch sleeve is not worn.
(b) Install the front drive clutch sleeve to the center
differential case and check that the front drive clutch
sleeve moves smoothly.
F044398
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER SYSTEM
TF–1
TRANSFER SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
• Before disassembly, clean the transfer assembly and
remove any deposited sand and mud to prevent it from
entering the transfer during disassembly and assembly.
• When removing any light alloy parts such as the transfer
covers, do not pry them off with a tool like a screwdriver,
but tap them out with a plastic hammer.
• Always organize the removed parts properly and protect
them from dust.
• After cleaning and drying the transfer completely before
installation, apply hypoid gear oil to each part. Do not use
alkaline chemicals when cleansing aluminum or rubber
parts or ring gear set bolts. Also, do not use any cleansing
oil (ex. white gasoline) to clean rubber parts such as oil
seals.
• Apply sufficient hypoid gear oil to all sliding surfaces and
rotating parts.
• Do not directly hold any parts in a vise. Be sure to put an
aluminum sheet between them.
• Replace any damaged or deformed snap rings with new
ones.
• If the mating surface of the case is scratched, it could
cause oil leakage. Therefore, handle with care to prevent
such damage.
• Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove old FIPG
from the seal surface.
• Clean all the components to remove the redundant FIPG
completely.
• Clean the sealing surface with solvent so that no residue
remains on the seal surface.
• Apply a line of FIPG approximately 1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
diameter of bead state along the sealing surface.
• Be sure to assemble parts within 10 minutes of application.
Otherwise, the FIPG must be removed and reapplied.
• Do not pour in oil immediately after installing sealed parts.
Leave it for at least an hour.
• Scratches on the contact surface with an oil seal or gasket
could cause oil leakage. Handle with care to prevent such
damage.
• When press-fitting an oil seal, take care to prevent the oil
seal lip and its periphery from being damaged.
• When servicing or disconnecting the 4WD ECU, be sure to
disconnect all power by removing the 20A 4WD fuse or the
negative battery terminal. Failure to disconnect power for
the 4WD ECU before performing Repair Manual diagnostic
procedures may cause the transfer case actuator to be
activated, resulting in damage to the transfer case
actuator.
TF
TF–2
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem.
The numbers indicate the ranked order of probability of each
of the possible causes.
Check each part in order.
Replace the applicable parts as necessary.
TRANSFER SYSTEM
Symptom
TF
Noise
Oil leakage
Tight corner braking
Shift from 4WD (H4) to 4WD (L4) impossible
Shift from 4WD (L4) to 4WD (H4) impossible
Suspected area
See page
1. Oil (Level low)
TF-3
2. Oil (Wrong)
TF-3
3. Transfer faulty
TF-8
1. Oil (Level too high)
TF-3
2. Gasket (Damaged)
TF-8
3. Oil seal (Worn or damaged)
TF-8
4. O-ring (Worn or damaged)
TF-8
1. Center differential or transfer faulty
TF-43
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-45
2. Wire harness
TF-46
3. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-46
1. Four wheel drive control switch
TF-45
2. Wire harness
TF-46
3. Four wheel drive control ECU
TF-46
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–33
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Install the low planetary ring gear to the front case.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
TF
F043456
2.
INSTALL WITH HEAD PIN
(a) Install w/ head pin.
3.
INSTALL COMPRESSION SPRING
4.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE PLUG
Torque: 18.6 N*m (190 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
(a) Install the transfer output shaft plate washer.
6.
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET BEARING
7.
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
8.
INSTALL NO. 1 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
9.
INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT REAR RADIAL
BALL BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new output shaft
rear radial ball bearing.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00071)
NOTICE:
Install the output shaft rear radial ball bearing so
that the bearing snap ring groove face to the
rear.
F043455
F043476
SST
Rear
F044046E01
TF–34
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
10. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT PLATE
WASHER
(a) Install the transfer output shaft plate washer.
11. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
12. INSTALL TRANSFER CLUTCH HUB
TF
F043510
13. INSTALL CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the center differential case.
14. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
BALL
15. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER NO.2
16. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expender, install the snap ring.
F044051
17. INSTALL DRIVE SPROCKET RADIAL CLEARANCE
18. INSPECT DRIVE SPROCKET THRUST CLEARANCE
19. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing with
the groove facing forward.
SST 09223-15020, 09515-30010, 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
SST
F043513E01
20. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
SPLINE PIECE
(a) Using a screwdriver, install the spline piece and low
planetary gear with the snap ring.
F043507
TF–35
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
21. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, tap in a new low planetary
gear bearing.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00570), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Press in depth:
7.7 to 8.3 mm (0.303 to 0.327 in.)
7.7 to 8.3mm
(0.303 to 0.327 in.)
SST
TF
F043469E01
22. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT BEARING SHAFT SNAP
RING
(a) Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial
play.
F043468
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
1
1.45 to 1.50 (0.0571 to 0.0591)
2
1.50 to 1.55 (0.0591 to 0.0610)
3
1.55 to 1.60 (0.0610 to 0.0630)
4
1.60 to 1.65 (0.0630 to 0.0650)
5
1.65 to 1.70 (0.0650 to 0.0669)
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
23. INSTALL TRANSFER NO. 1 INPUT SHAFT SEAL
RING
(a) Apply gear oil to the oil seal ring.
(b) Engage securely to eliminate clearance as shown in
the illustration.
F043460
24. INSTALL TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR
BEARING
(a) Install the transfer low planetary gear bearing.
Front
25. INSTALL NO. 1 TRANSFER THRUST BEARING RACE
26. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
F043454E01
TF–36
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
27. INSTALL MANUAL TRANSFER PLANETARY
CARRIER WASHER
(a) Install the manual transfer planetary carrier washer.
28. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER BALL
29. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER
TF
F043453
30. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR STOPPER SHAFT
SNAP RING
(a) Select an input gear stopper shaft snap ring that
allows 0.05 to 0.15 mm (0.0020 to 0.0059 in.) axial
play.
F043514
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
A
2.10 to 2.15 (0.0827 to 0.0846)
B
2.15 to 2.20 (0.0846 to 0.0866)
C
2.20 to 2.25 (0.0866 to 0.0886)
D
2.25 to 2.30 (0.0886 to 0.0906)
E
2.30 to 2.35 (0.0906 to 0.0925)
F
2.35 to 2.40 (0.0925 to 0.0945)
G
2.40 to 2.45 (0.0945 to 0.0965)
H
2.45 to 2.50 (0.0965 to 0.0984)
J
2.50 to 2.55 (0.0984 to 0.1004)
K
2.55 to 2.60 (0.1004 to 0.1024)
L
2.60 to 2.65 (0.1024 to 0.1043)
M
2.65 to 2.70 (0.1043 to 0.1063)
N
2.70 to 2.75 (0.1063 to 0.1083)
P
2.75 to 2.80 (0.1083 to 0.1102)
Q
2.80 to 2.85 (0.1102 to 0.1122)
R
2.85 to 2.90 (0.1122 to 0.1142)
S
2.90 to 2.95 (0.1142 to 0.1161)
T
2.95 to 3.00 (0.1161 to 0.1181)
U
3.00 to 3.05 (0.1181 to 0.1201)
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the new input
gear stopper shaft snap ring.
Q007289
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–37
31. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the case upper surface.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011)
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
TF
F043515E01
32. INSTALL LOW PLANETARY GEAR ASSEMBLY WITH
INPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the low planetary gear assembly with input
shaft sub-assembly.
F043450
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the shaft snap
ring.
F043449
33. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL PUMP GEAR
(a) Install transfer oil pump gear.
F043448
34. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY O-RING
(a) Coat a new O-ring with gear oil and install it to the
oil pump body.
F043463E01
TF–38
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
35. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the oil pump body sub-assembly with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
36. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE MAGNET
TF
F043447
37. INSTALL TRANSFER OIL SEPARATOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the oil separator sub-assembly with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
38. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE PLUG
(a) Install the case plug No. 1 (filler plug) and a new
gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (380 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
F043446
39. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE PLUG
(a) Install the case plug (drain plug) and a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (380 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
40. INSTALL TRANSFER SHIFT ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the shift actuator assembly with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive in the snap
ring.
F043445
41. INSTALL TRANSFER INPUT GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new input gear
radial ball bearing.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00031)
SST
F043464E02
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–39
42. INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVEN SPROCKET BEARING
(a) Using a press, install a new driven sprocket bearing.
TF
F044041
43. INSTALL REAR OUTPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY,
FRONT DRIVE CHAIN AND DRIVEN SPROCKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear output shaft sub-assembly, and drive
sprocket to the front drive chain.
F043442
(b) Install the rear output shaft sub-assembly, front
drive chain and driven sprocket sub-assembly to the
rear case.
HINT:
Check that the rear output shaft sub-assembly and
driven sprocket sub-assembly turn lightly.
F043441
44. INSTALL CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK FORK SUBASSEMBLY WITH FRONT DRIVE CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Install the CTR differential lock fork sub-assembly
and front drive clutch sleeve.
(b) Install the bolt.
Torque: 24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(c) Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive in the snap
ring.
Front
F043519E01
45. INSTALL TRANSFER GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2 WITH
TRANSFER HIGH AND LOW CLUTCH SLEEVE
(a) Install the gear shift fork No. 2 and high and low
clutch sleeve.
(b) Install the bolt.
Torque: 24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
Front
46. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
F044401E01
47. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
TF–40
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
FIPG
TF
48. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE REAR
(a) Apply FIPG to the case rear, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
F043488E01
(b) Install the clamp and case rear with the 12 bolts.
Torque: 28 N*m (285 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
F043433
49. INSTALL COLLAR
(a) Install collar.
50. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT WASHER
F043432
51. INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal
until its surface is flush with the housing upper
surface.
SST 09223-46011, 09631-32020
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
F043516E02
FIPG
F043489E01
52. INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING SUBASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Apply FIPG to the extension housing sub-assembly,
as shown in the illustration.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
(b) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–41
(c) Install the extension housing sub-assembly with the
5 bolts.
Torque: 12 N*m (122 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
TF
F043431
53. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal
(front side).
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00320), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
F043517E02
Front:
54. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE OIL SEAL
(a) Drive in a new output shaft companion flange oil
seal using the same procedure as for the oil seal.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00320), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
55. INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the companion flange sub-assembly (front
side) onto the drive sprocket sub-assembly.
(b) Using SST to hold the companion flange, install a
new companion flange lock nut.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 118 N*m (1,200 kgf*cm, 87 ft.*lbf)
(c) Using a chisel and hammer, stake the companion
flange lock nut.
Rear:
SST
56. INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, install the companion flange subassembly using the same procedure as for the
companion flange sub-assembly (rear side).
Torque: 118 N*m (1200 kgf*cm, 87 ft.*lbf)
SST 09330-00021
57. INSTALL BREATHER OIL DEFLECTOR
F044048E02
TF–42
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
58. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the case cover sub-assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
TF
F043428
59. INSTALL TRANSFER COVER TYPE T OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal
until its surface is flush with the retainer upper
surface.
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00590), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
F043518E02
FIPG
F043490E01
60. INSTALL TRANSFER BEARING RETAINER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Apply FIPG to the front bearing retainer subassembly, as shown in the illustration.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
(b) Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(c) Install the front bearing retainer sub-assembly with
the 5 bolts.
Torque: 11.5 N*m (117 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
61. INSTALL HOSES
F043427
INSTALLATION
F043500
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the transfer assembly with the 8 bolts.
Torque: 24 N*m (240 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the adaptor rear oil seal
with the transfer input gear spline.
2.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER (See page EM-67)
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
F043499
TF–43
3.
INSTALL FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER (See
page AT-362)
4.
CONNECT WIRE HARNESS
5.
CONNECT CONNECTOR
6.
INSTALL NO. 3 FRAME CROSSMEMBER SUBASSEMBLY (See page AT-362)
7.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(a) Install the transfer case lower protector with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL NO. 1 TRANSFER CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET (See page AT-362)
9.
CONNECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY (See page AT-362)
10. INSTALL NO. 1 OIL COOLER INLET TUBE (See page
AT-363)
11. CONNECT NO. 1 OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE (See
page AT-363)
12. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUBASSEMBLY (See page AT-363)
13. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
LH (See page AT-351)
14. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
(See page AT-363)
15. ADD TRANSFER OIL
HINT:
(See page TF-3)
16. ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (See page
AT-364)
17. INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
18. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (See page
PR-12)
19. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
(See page PR-19)
20. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See page AT363)
21. CONNECT OXYGEN SENSOR (See page AT-364)
22. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
23. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
24. INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
HINT:
(See page AT-316)
25. INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION (See page AT-364)
TF
TF–44
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
26. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
27. WARM UP
28. DRIVE TEST
TF
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER OIL
0 to 5 mm
(0 to 0.20 in.)
TF–3
TRANSFER OIL
ADJUSTMENT
1.
C083746E02
2.
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL
(a) Remove the filler plug and gasket.
(b) Check that the oil level is within 5 mm (0.20 in.) of
the bottom of the filler plug hole.
NOTICE:
• When replacing the oil, recheck the oil level
after driving.
• Excessively large or small quantities of oil
may cause troubles.
(c) When the oil level is too low, check for oil leakage.
(d) Tighten the filler plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
ADJUST TRANSFER OIL
(a) Remove the filler plug and gasket then supply oil.
NOTICE:
• When supplying oil, pour slowly.
• Pour the oil in several stages allowing several
minutes between each step.
HINT:
The oil level should be within 5 mm (0.20 in.) of the
bottom of the oil filler plug hole.
(b) After leaving it alone for 5 minutes, check the oil
level again.
(c) Tighten the filler plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
TF
TF–4
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
DRIVE LINE
VF4BM
TRANSFER
COMPONENTS
18 (185, 13)
TF
18.6 (190, 14)
CASE PLUG
CASE COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOW PLANETARY RING GEAR
COMPRESSION SPRING
BREATHER OIL
DEFLECTOR
HEAD PIN
SNAP RING
*
11.5 (117, 8)
x5
SNAP RING
OIL SEAL
FRONT BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER FRONT CASE
OIL SEAL
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
118 (1,200, 87)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
* Precoated part
C131342E03
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
TF–5
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL
2.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-17)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER
HINT:
(See page AT-358)
4.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-18)
5.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
case.
SST
F043485E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Coat the lip of a new oil seal with MP grease.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the case upper surface.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011)
2.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-40)
3.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER
HINT:
(See page AT-361)
4.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-41)
5.
ADD TRANSFER OIL
6.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
7.
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
8.
WARMING UP
9.
DRIVE TEST
SST
F043487E02
TF
TF–6
VF4BM TRANSFER – EXTENSION HOUSING OIL SEAL
EXTENSION HOUSING OIL SEAL
DRIVE LINE
VF4BM
TRANSFER
COMPONENTS
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
TF
TRANSFER EXTENSION
HOUSING TYPE T OIL SEAL
C139738E02
VF4BM TRANSFER – EXTENSION HOUSING OIL SEAL
TF–7
REMOVAL
SST
1.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL
2.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-17)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER
HINT:
(See page AT-358)
4.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-18)
5.
REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
extension housing sub-assembly rear.
F043484E02
INSTALLATION
SST
1.
INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Coat the lip of a new oil seal with MP grease.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the housing upper surface.
SST 09223-46011, 09631-32020
2.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page TF-40)
3.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WITH
TRANSFER
HINT:
(See page AT-361)
4.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE LOWER PROTECTOR
(See page TF-41)
5.
ADD TRANSFER OIL
6.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
7.
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
8.
WARMING UP
9.
DRIVE TEST
F043486E02
TF
TF–8
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
DRIVE LINE
VF4BM
TRANSFER
COMPONENTS
TF
88 (900, 65)
ATF LEVEL GAUGE
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
12 (122, 9)
88 (900, 65)
O-RING
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
34 (346, 25)
5 (50, 43 in.*lbf)
x5
24 (240, 17)
OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO. 1 AND
OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO. 1
18 (184, 13)
48 (490, 35)
TRANSFER
CASE LOWER
PROTECTOR
x6
24 (240, 17)
x3
FLYWHEEL HOUSING
UNDER COVER
TRANSMISSION
CONTROL CABLE
71 (720, 53)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
18 (184, 13)
88 (900, 65)
PROPELLER SHAFT
ASSEMBLY FRONT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
88 (900, 65)
Non-reusable part
C131350E02
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF–9
48 (490, 35)
GASKET
TF
EXHAUST PIPE
ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR REAR NO. 1
GASKET
62 (630, 46)
62 (630, 46)
GASKET
ENGINE UNDER COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 1
65 (663, 48)
FRONT CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 3
72 (734, 53)
72 (734, 53)
33 (336, 24)
ENGINE UNDER COVER
ASSEMBLY REAR
33 (336, 24)
FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET LH
FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER BRACKET
Non-reusable part
C131351E01
TF–10
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
18 (185, 13)
TF
CASE PLUG
18.6 (190, 14)
CASE COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BREATHER OIL
DEFLECTOR
COMPRESSION
SPRING
HEAD PIN
FRONT BEARING
RETAINER SUBASSEMBLY
SNAP RING
LOW PLANETARY
RING GEAR
11.5 (119, 8)
x5
SNAP RING
OIL SEAL
TRANSFER FRONT CASE
OIL SEAL
118 (1,200, 87)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
OIL SEAL
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
C131342E06
TF–11
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF
BALL
SPACER
TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
FRONT NEEDLE ROLLER
BEARING
TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
THRUST BEARING RACE NO. 1
TRANSFER LOW PLANETARY GEAR BEARING
LOW PLANETARY GEAR ASSEMBLY
PLANETARY CARR WASHER
INPUT GEAR STOPPER
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
SNAP RING
MAGNET
TRANSFER OIL
PUMP GEAR
TRANSFER OIL PUMP BODY SUB-ASSEMBLY
O-RING
TRANSFER OIL SEPARATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.5 (80, 66 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131343E03
TF–12
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
20 (200, 15)
CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
FORK SUB-ASSEMBLY
TF
20 (200, 15)
SNAP RING
24 (245, 18)
GEAR SHIFT FORK NO. 2
SNAP RING
TRANSFER SHIFT
ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
CLAMP
x12
24 (245, 18)
28 (285, 21)
GASKET
REAR OUTPUT SHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
37 (380, 27)
NO. 1 PLUG
(FILLER PLUG)
37 (380, 27)
GASKET
NO. 1 PLUG
(DRAIN PLUG)
TRANSFER CASE REAR
FRONT DRIVE
CLUTCH SLEEVE
FRONT DRIVE CHAIN
HIGH AND LOW
CLUTCH SLEEVE
DRIVEN SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131353E01
TF–13
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
TF
12 (120, 9)
118 (1,200, 87)
x5
OIL SEAL
OIL SEAL
OUTPUT SHAFT COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
COLLAR
OUTPUT WASHER
SNAP RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
C131568E01
TF–14
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
INPUT SHAFT:
TRANSFER NO. 1 INPUT
SHAFT SEAL RING
TF
TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT
Non-reusable part
C131346E03
DRIVEN SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY:
DRIVEN SPROCKET
TRANSFER INPUT GEAR
RADIAL BALL BEARING
Non-reusable part
TRANSFER DRIVEN
SPROCKET BEARING
C131347E03
TF–15
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
LOW PLANETARY GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY:
SNAP RING
TF
LOW PLANETARY GEAR
LOW PLANETARY
GEAR BEARING
TRANSFER LOW
PLANETARY GEAR
SPLINE PIECE
TRANSFER INPUT SHAFT BEARING
SNAP RING
Non-reusable part
C131348E04
TF–16
VF4BM TRANSFER – TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
REAR OUTPUT SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY:
TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
REAR RADIAL BALL BEARING
NO. 1 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT SPACER
DRIVE SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
TF
DRIVE SPROCKET BEARING
OUTPUT SHAFT
PLATE WASHER
TRANSFER OUTPUT
SHAFT REAR
OUTPUT SHAFT
PLATE WASHER
TRANSFER OUTPUT
SHAFT FRONT NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING
BALL
CLUTCH HUB
CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE
SNAP RING
NO. 2 TRANSFER OUTPUT SHAFT
SPACER
Non-reusable part
C131357E01
VF4BM TRANSFER – CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
TF–43
CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
DRIVE LINE
VF4BM
TRANSFER
PARTS LOCATION
TF
DIFFERENTIAL
LOCK SWITCH
FOUR WHEEL DRIVE
CONTROL ECU
FOUR WHEEL DRIVE
CONTROL SWITCH
TRANSFER SHIFT
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
C131358E02
TF–44
VF4BM TRANSFER – CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
INSPECTION
NOTICE:
• Switch the four wheel drive control switch under the
condition that A/T shift lever is in "N" position and the
vehicle speed is 5 km/h or less.
• Do not operate the four wheel drive control switch
and the differential lock switch at the same time.
1.
INSPECT H4 (DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "FREE") TO H4
(DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and the differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch to "H4"
position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds. Check that the center diff. lock indicator
light goes off after pressing the differential lock
switch for 2 seconds.
2.
INSPECT L4 (DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "FREE" TO H4
(DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch to "L4"
position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
(d) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds. Check that the center diff. lock indicator
light goes off after pressing the differential lock
switch for 2seconds.
3.
INSPECT H4 (DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "FREE") TO L4
(DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "L4" position while pressing it.
(c) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
(d) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"L4" position to the "H4" position while pressing it.
(e) Check that the 4LO indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
TF
F044042
F044043
F044044
TF–45
VF4BM TRANSFER – CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
4.
INSPECT H4 (DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "LOCK") TO L4
(DIFFERENTIAL LOCK "LOCK") SHIFT
(a) Start the engine, and differential lock switch is in
"OFF" position.
(b) Check that the center diff. lock indicator light comes
on after pressing the differential lock switch for 2
seconds.
(c) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"H4" position to the "L4" position while pressing it.
(d) Check that the 4LO indicator light comes on after it
is blinking.
(e) Turn the four wheel drive control switch from the
"L4" position to the "H4" position while pressing it.
(f) Check that the 4LO indicator light goes off after it is
blinking.
F044045
5.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SWITCH
CONTINUITY
(a) Remove the instrument panel finish lower panel
sub- assembly.
(b) Remove the differential lock switch from the
instrument panel finish lower sub-assembly.
(c) Inspect the continuity between the each terminal.
Switch position
OFF
ON
ILL-
GND
+B
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
+B (3) - GND (4)
No continuity
Hold ON
+B (3) - GND (4)
Continuity
Illumination
ILL+ (1) - ILL- (2)
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the
differential lock switch or bulb.
ILL+
F044040E02
6.
GND
ILL-
LO
ILL+
INSPECT FOUR WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL SWITCH
(a) (a) Remove the center instrument cluster finish
panel sub- assembly.
(b) Remove the four wheel drive control switch from the
center instrument cluster finish panel sub-assembly.
(c) Inspect the continuity between the each terminals.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
H4
LO (2) - GND (4)
No continuity
L4
LO (2) - GND (4)
Continuity
Illumination
ILL+ (1) - ILL- (3)
Continuity
F044039E04
If continuity is not as specified, replace the four
wheel drive control switch or bulb.
TF
TF–46
VF4BM TRANSFER – CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
7.
INSPECT ACTUATOR
NOTICE:
Inspection for the actuator must be done with the
actuator installed on the transfer assembly.
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(b) Check the operating sound produced by four wheel
drive control switch operation and the differential
lock switch operation.
If the operating sound cannot be heard, check the
four wheel control ECU and the wire harness in the
next step. When the wire harness and four wheel
drive control ECU is normal, replace the actuator.
8.
INSPECT WIRE HARNESS
(a) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal or remove the 20A 4WD fuse.
CAUTION:
Failure to disconnect power for the 4WD ECU
may cause the transfer case actuator to be
activated, resulting in damage to the transfer
case actuator.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector and four wheel
drive control ECU connector.
(c) Check continuity on the wire harness between four
wheel drive control ECU and the actuator.
TF
Four Wheel Drive Control ECU Connector
F10
Transfer Shift Actuator Connector
T3
F044038E02
Tester connection
Specified condition
TM1 (F10-2) - TM1 (T3-2)
Continuity
TM2 (F10-5) - TM2 (T3-1)
Continuity
TL2 (F10-24) - TL2 (T3-4)
Continuity
TL3 (F10-23) - TL3 (T3-5)
Continuity
HM2 (F10-4) - HM2 (T3-7)
Continuity
HM1 (F10-1) - HM1 (T3-8)
Continuity
P1 (F10-22) - CDL (T3-9)
Continuity
HL2 (F10-26) - HL2 (T3-11)
Continuity
HL1 (F10-17) - HL1 (T3-12)
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, repair or replace the
wire harness.
9.
INSPECT FOUR WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL ECU
(a) Connect the wire harness side connector to the four
wheel drive control ECU.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal
or install the 20A 4WD fuse.
TF–47
VF4BM TRANSFER – CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
(c) Inspect the wire harness side connector from the
back side, as shown below.
F9
F10
TF
C134067E02
STANDARD VALUE OF ECU TERMINAL
Terminals (Symbols)
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
F9-9 (SPD) - F9-1 (GND)
During driving
Pulse generation
F9-22 (N) - F9-1 (GND)
F9-16 (DL) - F9-1 (GND)
F10-23 (TL3) - F9-1 (GND)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Transmission shift lever other position →
Transmission shift lever N position
10 to 14 → 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position
→ Keep pressing the differential lock
switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
10 to 14 → 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position
→ Keep pressing the differential lock
switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
2 or less → 10 to 14
F9-6 (IG) - F9-1 (GND)
F10-2 (TM1) - F10- 5 (TM2)
F9-15 (LO) - F9-1 (GND)
F9-20 (IND2) - F9-1 (GND)
F9-11 (IND3) - F9-1 (GND)
F10-24 (TL2) - F9-1 (GND)
Ignition switch ON
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Keep pressing the differential lock switch
approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
10 to 14 → 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position
→ Keep pressing the differential lock
switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
10 to 14 → 1.5 to 3.5
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
10 to 14 → 1.5 to 3.5
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Differential lock switch is in "OFF" position
→ Keep pressing the differential lock
switch approx. 2 seconds to turn it ON
10 to 14 → 2 or less
F9-1 (GND) - Body ground
F9-24 (L4) - F9-1 (GND)
F10-1 (HM1) - F9-1 (GND)
10 to 14
Ignition switch OFF
10 to 14 (for about 5 seconds) then less than
0.5
Continuity
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
10 to 14 → 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
10 to 14 → 2 or less
TF–48
VF4BM TRANSFER – CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SYSTEM
Terminals (Symbols)
F10-4 (HM2) - F9-1 (GND) 14
F10-17 (HL1) - F9-1 (GND)
TF
F10-26 (HL2) - F9-1 (GND)
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
2 or less → 10 to 14
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
10 to 14 → 2 or less
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Four wheel drive control switch "H4"
position → Four wheel drive control switch
"L4" position
2 or less → 10 to 14
PR–6
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(f)
2.
PR
• Must use retainer rings of the same thickness
as possible on both ends.
Using a hammer, tap the yoke until there is no
clearance between the spider bearing outer race
and snap ring.
HINT:
Install a new spider bearing on the sleeve side in the
procedure described above.
INSPECT REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
INSTALLATION
SST
1.
INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the SST from the extension housing.
SST 09325-40010
(b) Install the propeller shaft assembly in the extension
housing.
C098710E03
(c) Align the matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange
and differential flange.
(d) Install the propeller shaft assembly with the 4 nuts
and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
C098711E02
PR–10
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
INSPECTION
C061260
1.
INSPECT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the propeller shaft
runout.
Maximum runout:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
If the shaft runout is greater than maximum, replace
the shaft.
2.
INSPECT REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Check the spider bearings for wear or damage.
(b) Check the spider bearing axial play by turning the
yoke with holding the shaft tightly.
Maximum bearing axial play:
0 mm(0 in.)
If necessary, replace the spider bearing.
PR
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Apply MP grease No. 2 to a new spider and
bearings.
(b) Fit the spider into the flange yoke.
C060598
(c) Using SST, install the bearings on the spider.
SST 09332-25010
(d) Using SST, adjust both bearings so that the snap
ring grooves are at maximum and equal in width.
SST 09332-25010
SST
C063061E04
(e) Install new 4 snap rings of equal thickness which
will allow no axial play.
HINT:
Do not reuse the snap rings.
Thickness of snap ring (Both ends thin type)
G020755
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
90520-25039
2.28 to 2.30
1
90520-25040
2.30 to 2.32
2
90520-25041
2.32 to 2.34
-
90520-25042
2.34 to 2.36
Brown
90520-25043
2.36 to 2.38
Blue
90520-25044
2.38 to 2.40
6
90520-25045
2.40 to 2.42
7
90520-25046
2.42 to 2.44
8
PR–11
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
90520-25047
2.44 to 2.46
90520-25048
2.46 to 2.48
10
90520-25049
2.48 to 2.50
A
90520-25050
2.50 to 2.52
B
90520-25051
2.52 to 2.54
C
90520-25052
2.54 to 2.56
D
90520-25053
2.56 to 2.58
E
90520-25054
2.18 to 2.20
J
90520-25055
2.20 to 2.22
K
90520-25056
2.22 to 2.24
F
90520-25057
2.24 to 2.26
G
90520-25058
2.26 to 2.28
H
(f)
SST
Mark
NOTICE:
• Must use a new retainer ring.
• Must use retainer rings of the same thickness
as possible on both ends.
Using a hammer, tap the yoke until there is no
clearance between the spider bearing outer race
and snap ring.
HINT:
Install a new spider bearing on the sleeve side in the
procedure described above.
2.
INSTALL REAR PROPELLER SHAFT SLIDING
SHAFT DUST COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and press, press in a new dust cover.
NOTICE:
Place the universal joint straight when pressing
in the dust cover. Apply MP grease to the "A"
part.
3.
INSTALL RR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL JOINT
SLEEVE YOKE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the grease fitting to the universal joint sleeve
yoke.
(b) Apply MP grease to the propeller shaft spline and
sleeve yoke sliding surface.
(c) Align the matchmarks on the sleeve yoke propeller
shaft.
(d) Install the propeller shaft into the sleeve yoke.
4.
INSPECT REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(A)
D003049E01
Matchmarks
G022296E02
PR
PR–12
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
5.
INSPECT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
HINT:
When replacing the spider bearing, be sure that the
grease fitting assembly hole is facing to the direction
shown in the illustration.
SPIDER GREASE FITTING ASSEMBLY DIRECTION FOR PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Rear Side
PR
G022300E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange
and differential flange.
(b) Install the propeller shaft assembly with the 4 bolts,
4 nuts and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
C098700E04
(c) Align the matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange
and transfer flange.
(d) Install the propeller shaft assembly with the 4 nuts
and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
C098699E04
PR–16
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
C029928
1.
INSPECT FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the propeller shaft
runout.
Maximum runout:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
If the shaft runout is greater than maximum, replace
the propeller shaft.
2.
INSPECT FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Check the spider bearings for wear or damage.
(b) Check the spider bearing axial play by turning the
yoke with holding the shaft tightly.
Maximum bearing axial play:
0 mm (0 in.)
If necessary, replace the spider bearing.
PR
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Apply MP grease No. 2 to a new spider and spider
bearing.
(b) Fit the spider into the flange yoke.
Z004248
(c) Using SST, install the spider bearings on the spider.
SST 09332-25010
(d) Using SST, adjust both bearings so that the snap
ring grooves are at maximum and equal in width.
SST 09332-25010
SST
C063061E06
(e) Install 4 new snap rings of equal thickness which
will allow no axial play.
HINT:
Do not reuse the snap rings.
Thickness of snap ring
G020755
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
90520-25039
2.28 to 2.30
1
90520-25040
2.30 to 2.32
2
90520-25041
2.32 to 2.34
-
90520-25042
2.34 to 2.36
Brown
90520-25043
2.36 to 2.38
Blue
90520-25044
2.38 to 2.40
6
90520-25045
2.40 to 2.42
7
90520-25046
2.42 to 2.44
8
PR–17
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
90520-25047
2.44 to 2.46
90520-25048
2.46 to 2.48
10
90520-25049
2.48 to 2.50
A
90520-25050
2.50 to 2.52
B
90520-25051
2.52 to 2.54
C
90520-25052
2.54 to 2.56
D
90520-25053
2.56 to 2.58
E
90520-25054
2.18 to 2.20
J
90520-25055
2.20 to 2.22
K
90520-25056
2.22 to 2.24
F
90520-25057
2.24 to 2.26
G
90520-25058
2.26 to 2.28
H
NOTICE:
• Must use a new retainer ring.
• Must use retainer rings of the same thickness
as possible on both ends.
(f)
Using a hammer, tap the yoke until there is no
clearance between the spider bearing outer race
and snap ring.
HINT:
Install a new spider bearing on the sleeve side in the
procedure described above.
(g) Align the matchmarks on the flange yoke and the
sleeve yoke.
Hammering Point
G022297E04
SST
F044258E03
(h) Using SST, install the spider bearings on the spider.
SST 09332-25010
(i) Using SST, adjust both bearings so that the snap
ring grooves are at maximum and equal in width.
SST 09332-25010
(j) Install new 4 snap rings of equal thickness which
will allow no axial play.
HINT:
Do not reuse the snap rings.
Thickness of snap ring
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
90520-25039
2.28 to 2.30
1
90520-25040
2.30 to 2.32
2
90520-25041
2.32 to 2.34
-
90520-25042
2.34 to 2.36
Brown
90520-25043
2.36 to 2.38
Blue
90520-25044
2.38 to 2.40
6
90520-25045
2.40 to 2.42
7
90520-25046
2.42 to 2.44
8
PR
PR–18
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
PR
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
90520-25047
2.44 to 2.46
90520-25048
2.46 to 2.48
10
90520-25049
2.48 to 2.50
A
90520-25050
2.50 to 2.52
B
90520-25051
2.52 to 2.54
C
90520-25052
2.54 to 2.56
D
90520-25053
2.56 to 2.58
E
90520-25054
2.18 to 2.20
J
90520-25055
2.20 to 2.22
K
90520-25056
2.22 to 2.24
F
90520-25057
2.24 to 2.26
G
90520-25058
2.26 to 2.28
H
NOTICE:
• Must use a new retainer ring.
• Must use retainer rings of the same thickness
as possible on both ends.
(k) Using a plastic hammer, tap the yoke until there is
no clearance between the spider bearing outer race
and snap ring.
HINT:
Install a new spider bearing on the sleeve side in the
procedure described above.
Hammering Point
SST
G022298E02
2.
INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT SLIDING
SHAFT DUST COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and press, press in a new dust cover.
SST 09636-20010
NOTICE:
Place the universal joint straight when pressing
in the dust cover. Apply MP grease to the "A"
part.
3.
INSTALL FR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL JOINT
SLEEVE YOKE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the grease fitting to the universal joint sleeve
yoke.
(b) Apply MP grease to the propeller shaft spline and
sleeve yoke sliding surface.
(c) Align the matchmarks on the sleeve yoke propeller
shaft.
(d) Install the propeller shaft into the sleeve yoke.
4.
INSPECT FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
A
D003049E02
Matchmarks
G022296E05
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
5.
PR–19
INSPECT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
HINT:
When replacing the spider bearing, be sure that the
grease fitting assembly hole is facing to the direction
shown in the illustration.
SPIDER GREASE FITTING ASSEMBLY DIRECTION FOR PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY FRONT
Rear Side
PR
C098696E03
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the yoke and differential
flange.
(b) Install the propeller shaft assembly with the 4 bolts,
4 nuts and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
C098708E06
Matchmarks
C098709E05
(c) Align the matchmarks on the yoke and transfer
flange.
(d) Install the propeller shaft assembly with the 4 nuts
and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
PR–1
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT SYSTEM
PROPELLER SHAFT SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to find the cause of the problem. The
numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause of the
problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace
these parts.
PROPELLER SHAFT
Symptom
Noise
Vibration
Suspected area
See page
1. Spider bearing (Worn or stuck) (2WD)
PR-4
2. Spider bearing (Worn or stuck) (4WD)
PR-10
1. Propeller shaft (Runout) (2WD)
PR-4
2. Propeller shaft (Runout) (4WD)
PR-10
3. Propeller shaft (Imbalance)
-
PR
PR–2
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
DRIVE LINE SHAFT
PROPELLER
COMPONENTS
PR
88 (897, 65)
SPIDER BEARING
SNAP RING
x4
x4
x4
x4
SPIDER BEARING
x4
SNAP RING
SPIDER
x4
UNIVERSAL JOINT
FLANGE YOKE
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
SPIDER
UNIVERSAL JOINT
SLEEVE YOKE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
MP grease No. 2
C131367E01
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
PR–3
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
differential flange.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts and 4 washers.
Matchmarks
C098711E01
(c) Remove the propeller shaft.
(d) Insert SST in the transmission to prevent oil
leakage.
SST 09325-40010
SST
C098710E02
DISASSEMBLY
Matchmarks
1.
REMOVE REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Place matchmarks on the flange yoke and sleeve
yoke.
F015023E06
(b) Using a brass bar and a hammer, slightly tap in the
spider bearing outer races.
(c) Using 2 screwdrivers, remove the 4 snap rings from
the grooves.
C061264
(d) Using SST, push out the spider bearing from the
propeller shaft.
SST 09332-25010
HINT:
Sufficiently raise the part indicated by (A) so that it
does not come into contact with the spider bearing.
SST
(A)
F015025E06
PR
PR–4
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(e) Clamp the spider bearing outer race in a vise and
tap off the propeller shaft with a hammer.
HINT:
Remove the spider bearing on opposite side in the
same procedure.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the shaft.
Hammering
Point
F044192E03
(f)
Install the 2 removed spider bearing outer races to
the spider.
(g) Using SST, push out the bearing from the yoke.
SST 09332-25010
HINT:
Sufficiently raise the part indicated by (A) so that it
does not come into contact with the bearing.
PR
(A)
SST
F015030E05
(h) Clamp the outer bearing race in a vise and tap off
the yoke with a hammer.
(i) Remove the spider.
Hammering Point
F044193E04
INSPECTION
C061260
1.
INSPECT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the propeller shaft
runout.
Maximum runout:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
If the shaft runout is greater than maximum, replace
the shaft.
2.
INSPECT REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Check the spider bearings for wear or damage.
(b) Check the spider bearing axial play by turning the
yoke with holding the shaft tightly.
Maximum bearing axial play:
0 mm (0 in.)
If necessary, replace the spider bearing.
PR–5
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Apply MP grease No. 2 to a new spider and
bearings.
(b) Fit the spider into the flange yoke.
C060598
(c) Using SST, install the bearings on the spider.
SST 09332-25010
(d) Using SST, adjust both bearings so that the snap
ring grooves are at maximum and equal in width.
SST 09332-25010
SST
C063061E03
(e) Install new 4 snap rings of equal thickness which
will allow no axial play.
HINT:
Do not reuse the snap rings.
Thickness of snap ring (Both ends thin type)
G020755
Parts No.
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
90520-25039
2.28 to 2.30
1
90520-25040
2.30 to 2.32
2
90520-25041
2.32 to 2.34
-
90520-25042
2.34 to 2.36
Brown
90520-25043
2.36 to 2.38
Blue
90520-25044
2.38 to 2.40
6
90520-25045
2.40 to 2.42
7
90520-25046
2.42 to 2.44
8
90520-25047
2.44 to 2.46
90520-25048
2.46 to 2.48
10
90520-25049
2.48 to 2.50
A
90520-25050
2.50 to 2.52
B
90520-25051
2.52 to 2.54
C
90520-25052
2.54 to 2.56
D
90520-25053
2.56 to 2.58
E
90520-25054
2.18 to 2.20
J
90520-25055
2.20 to 2.22
K
90520-25056
2.22 to 2.24
F
90520-25057
2.24 to 2.26
G
90520-25058
2.26 to 2.28
H
NOTICE:
• Must use a new retainer ring.
PR
PR–7
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DRIVE LINE SHAFT
PROPELLER
COMPONENTS
PR
88 (897, 65)
SPIDER BEARING
x4
x4 x4
x4
SNAP RING
x4
88 (897, 65)
SPIDER BEARING
x4
x4
SNAP RING
SPIDER
x4
x4
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
DUST COVER
SPIDER
UNIVERSAL JOINT SLEEVE YOKE
GREASE FITTING
UNIVERSAL JOINT FLANGE YOKE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
MP grease
MP grease No. 2
C131577E01
PR–8
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
transfer flange.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts, 4 washers and propeller shaft
assembly.
Matchmarks
C098699E03
(c) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
differential flange.
(d) Remove the 4 nuts, 4 bolts and 4 washers.
PR
Matchmarks
C098700E03
DISASSEMBLY
Matchmarks
1.
REMOVE RR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SLEEVE YOKE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft and sleeve
yoke.
(b) Remove the sleeve yoke from the propeller shaft.
(c) Remove the grease fitting from the universal joint
sleeve yoke.
2.
REMOVE REAR PROPELLER SHAFT SLIDING
SHAFT DUST COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Cut the dust cover spirally at the pressing-in part
with a saw and pry it off with a chisel.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the propeller shaft. If damage,
replace the shaft with a new one.
3.
REMOVE REAR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SPIDER BEARING
(a) Place matchmarks on the flange yoke and sleeve
yoke.
G022296E01
1.2 mm
(0.047 in.)
19.5 mm
(0.768 in.)
D003048E02
Matchmarks
F015023E08
PROPELLER SHAFT – PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
PR–9
(b) Using a brass bar and a hammer, slightly tap in the
spider bearing outer races.
(c) Using 2 screwdrivers, remove the 4 snap rings from
the grooves.
C061264
(d) Using SST, push out the spider bearing from the
propeller shaft.
SST 09332-25010
HINT:
Sufficiently raise the part indicated by (A) so that it
does not come into contact with the spider bearing.
SST
(A)
F015025E07
Hammering
Point
(e) Clamp the spider bearing outer race in a vise and
tap off the propeller shaft with a hammer.
HINT:
Remove the spider bearing on opposite side in the
same procedure.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the shaft.
F044192E04
(f)
Install the 2 removed spider bearing outer races to
the spider.
(g) Using SST, push out the bearing from the yoke.
SST 09332-25010
HINT:
Sufficiently raise the part indicated by (A) so that it
does not come into contact with the bearing.
(A)
SST
F015030E06
(h) Clamp the outer bearing race in a vise and tap off
the yoke with a hammer.
(i) Remove the spider.
Hammering Point
F044193E05
PR
PR–13
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
DRIVE LINE SHAFT
PROPELLER
COMPONENTS
PR
UNIVERSAL JOINT FLANGE YOKE
88 (897, 65)
SPIDER BEARING
SNAP RING
88 (897, 65)
UNIVERSAL SLEEVE
FLANGE YOKE
x4 x4
x4
x4
SPIDER BEARING
x4
x4
x4
SPIDER
SNAP RING
x4
x4
DUST COVER
GREASE FITTING
FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
SPIDER
UNIVERSAL JOINT FLANGE YOKE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
MP grease
MP grease No. 2
C131366E01
PR–14
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
differential.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts, 4 bolts, 4 washers and front
propeller shaft assembly.
Matchmarks
C098708E05
(c) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
transfer flange.
(d) Remove the 4 nuts, 4 washers and front propeller
shaft assembly.
PR
Matchmarks
C098709E04
DISASSEMBLY
Matchmarks
1.
REMOVE FR PROPELLER SHAFT UNIVERSAL
JOINT SLEEVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft and sleeve
yoke.
(b) Remove the sleeve yoke from the propeller shaft.
(c) Remove the grease fitting from the universal joint
sleeve yoke.
2.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT SLIDING
SHAFT DUST COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Cut the dust cover spirally at the pressing-in part
with a saw and pry it off with a chisel and a hammer.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the propeller shaft. If damage,
replace the shaft with a new one.
3.
REMOVE FRONT UNIVERSAL JOINT SPIDER
BEARING
(a) Place matchmarks on the flange yoke and sleeve
yoke.
G022296E04
1.2 mm
(0.047 in.)
19.5 mm
(0.768 in.)
D003048E03
Matchmarks
F015023E09
PROPELLER SHAFT – FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
PR–15
(b) Using a brass bar and a hammer, slightly tap in the
spider bearing outer races.
(c) Using 2 screwdrivers, remove the 4 snap rings from
the grooves.
C061264
(d) Using SST, push out the spider bearing from the
propeller shaft.
SST 09332-25010
HINT:
Sufficiently raise the part indicated by (A) so that it
does not come into contact with the spider bearing.
SST
(A)
F015025E08
Hammering
Point
(e) Clamp the spider bearing outer race in a vise and
tap off the propeller shaft with a hammer.
HINT:
Remove the bearing on opposite side in the same
procedure.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the shaft.
F044192E05
(f)
Install the 2 removed spider bearing outer races to
the spider.
(g) Using SST, push out the bearing from the yoke.
SST 09332-25010
HINT:
Sufficiently raise the part indicated by (A) so that it
does not come into contact with the bearing.
(A)
SST
F015030E07
(h) Clamp the outer bearing race in a vise and tap off
the flange yoke with a hammer.
(i) Remove the spider.
Hammering Point
F044193E06
PR
DS–4
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
DS
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
3.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and a adjusting cap.
(b) Remove the front axle hub LH nut.
4.
SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Using a hexagon wrench, separate the front speed
sensor.
(b) Disengage the 2 clamps.
(c) Remove the bolt and separate the speed sensor
wire harness from the steering knuckle.
5.
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
F042732
F042730
(b) Using SST, separate the tie rod end from the
steering knuckle.
SST 09628-62011
F042735
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
DS–5
6.
SEPARATE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER
ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the No. 1 front
suspension lower arm sub-assembly from the
steering knuckle.
7.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using SST, remove the front drive shaft.
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
F042737
SST
8.
F042739E01
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by the same procedure with LH
side.
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP
(a) Using a screwdriver, disclamp the inboard joint boot
clamp.
(b) Using the same manner to the inboard joint small
boot clamp.
2.
SEPARATE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
3.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE INBOARD JOINT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the tripod, inboard and
outboard joint shafts.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(b) Remove the inboard joint from the outboard joint
shaft.
F043637
Matchmarks
FA01615E03
(c) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
G022501
DS
DS–6
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(d) Place matchmarks on the outboard joint shaft and
tripod.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(e) Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the tripod
from the drive shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
Matchmarks
N000194E02
4.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP
(a) Using a screwdriver, disclamp the inboard joint boot
clamps.
HINT:
If the outboard joint boot clamps that have been
replaced are installed to the drive shaft, use a side
cutter to remove them.
(b) Using the same manner to the outboard joint small
boot clamp.
5.
REMOVE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
6.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT OUTER
SHAFT SNAP RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
7.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the dust cover.
SST 09950-00020
DS
C063445
C057543
SST
F040647E01
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
8.
DS–7
REMOVE STEERING KNUCKLE LH OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, remove the oil
seal.
C034791
INSPECTION
1.
F052122
INSPECT FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Check whether there is no remarkable play in the
outboard joint.
(b) Check whether the inboard joint slides smoothly in
the thrust direction.
(c) Check whether there is no remarkable play in the
radial direction of the inboard joint.
(d) Check the boots for damage.
NOTICE:
Move the drive shaft while keeping it level.
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL STEERING KNUCKLE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, install a new oil
seal.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil seal.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new dust cover.
SST 09527-10011
3.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT OUTER
SHAFT SNAP RING
(a) Install a new snap ring.
4.
INSTALL OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
HINT:
Before installing the boots, wrap the spline of the drive
shaft with vinyl tape to prevent the boots from being
damaged.
(a) Temporary install a new outboard joint boot with 2
new clamps onto the outboard joint shaft.
C034792
SST
F041033E01
Vinyl Tape
W001994E07
DS
DS–8
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(b) Pack the outboard joint assembly and boot with
grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity:
260 to 270 g (9.2 to 9.5 oz.)
5.
SST
DS
INSTALL FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP
(a) Mount drive shaft in a soft vice.
(b) Sure the outboard joint boot clamps onto the boot.
(c) Place SST onto the outboard joint large boot clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(d) Tighten the SST so that the large clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
F052126E01
(e) Using SST, adjust the clearance of the large clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
(f) Employ the same manner to the outboard joint small
boot clamp.
SST
6.
INSTALL INBOARD JOINT BOOT
(a) Provisionally install a new inboard joint boot the
outboard joint shaft.
7.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE INBOARD JOINT ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the beveled side of the tripod axle spline
toward the inboard joint.
(b) Align the matchmarks and install the tripod into the
inboard joint.
(c) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap the tripod into
the drive shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
(d) Pack the inboard joint assembly and boot with
grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity:
231 to 241 g (8.1 to 8.5 oz.)
F052127E01
Beveled
Matchmarks
C067417E02
(e) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
G022501
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
DS–9
8.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP
(a) Bend the band and lock a new inboard joint large
boot clamp with a screwdriver.
(b) Using the same manner to the inboard joint small
boot clamp.
9.
INSPECT FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Check whether there is no remarkable play in the
outboard joint.
(b) Check whether the inboard joint slides smoothly in
the thrust direction.
(c) Check whether there is no remarkable play in the
radial direction of the inboard joint.
(d) Check the boots for damage.
NOTICE:
Move the drive shaft while keeping it level.
C083397
F052122
INSTALLATION
1.
F042771
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Coat the spline of the inboard joint shaft assembly
with ATF.
(b) Align the shaft splines and install the drive shaft with
a brass bar and hammer.
NOTICE:
• Set the snap ring with the opening side facing
downward.
• Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
HINT:
Whether the inboard joint shaft is in contact with the
pinion shaft or not can be confirmed from the sound
or feeling when driving it.
DS
DS–10
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Install the speed sensor wire harness to the steering
knuckle with a bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 clips.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench, install the speed sensor
with the bolt.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 front suspension lower ball joint
attachment with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 160 N*m (1,631 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the tie rod end onto the steering knuckle.
(b) Install the nut.
Torque: 91 N*m (928 kgf*cm, 67 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install a new cotter pin.
NOTICE:
If the holes for the cotter pin are not aligned,
tighten the nut further to 60°.
5.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
(a) Install the hub nut.
Torque: 294 N*m (3,000 kgf*cm, 217 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin and adjusting cap.
6.
FILL UP DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
7.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
8.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
DS
F042730
F042737
F043604
F042732
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
9.
DS–11
CHECK VSC SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
DS
DS–1
DRIVE SHAFT – DRIVE SHAFT SYSTEM
DRIVE SHAFT SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to find the cause of the problem. The
numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause of the
problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace
these parts.
Symptom
Front wheel shimmy
Suspected area
Front drive shaft (worn)
See page
DS-6
DS
DS–2
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
DRIVE SHAFT
LINE
COMPONENTS
DS
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
8.3 (85, 73 in.*lbf)
13 (133, 10)
SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
COTTER PIN
294 (3,000, 217)
91 (928, 67)
ADJUSTING CAP
TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
COTTER PIN
160 (1, 630, 118)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131368E01
DS–3
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
SUPPLY PARTS:
FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT
OUTER SHAFT SNAP RING
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER
FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP
FRONT DRIVE INBOARD
JOINT ASSEMBLY
DS
SNAP RING
FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP
TRIPOD
INBOARD JOINT BOOT
FRONT AXLE INBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP
OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
FRONT DRIVE OUTBOARD JOINT ASSEMBLY
STEERING KNUCKLE LH OIL SEAL
Non-reusable part
C131567E01
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
DF–7
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
BEARING SPACER
(a) Install a new rear differential drive pinion bearing
spacer.
2.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install a new oil
storage ring.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, install the front bearing
outer race.
(c) Install the front bearing.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00021)
3.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
4.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal.
SST 09554-30011
Oil seal drive in depth:
0.7 to 1.3 mm (0.0276 to 0.0512 in.)
(b) Coat oil seal lip with MP grease.
5.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE COMPANION FLANGE SUBASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using SST, install the companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03030)
(b) Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil
LSD.
SST
F040719E02
SST
F040716E02
SST
C088916E02
(c) Using SST to hold the companion flange, tighten the
nut.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030)
Torque: 215 N*m (2,190 kgf*cm, 159 ft.*lbf)
DF
DF–8
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
6.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring rear.
New bearing:
1.05 to 1.64 N*m (10.7 to 16.7 kgf*cm, 9.3 to
14.5 in.*lbf)
Reused bearing:
0.56 to 0.85 N*m (5.7 to 8.7 kgf*cm, 5.0 to 7.5
in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential assembly.
7.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
(a) Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the nut.
8.
INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the propeller shaft
differential flange.
(b) 2WD Drive Type:
Install the propeller shaft with the 4 washers and 4
nuts.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
(c) 4WD Drive Type:
Install the propeller shaft with the 4 bolts, 4 washers
and 4 nuts.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
9.
FILL UP DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
C089308
DF
C089310
Matchmarks
C060588E02
10. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–15
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
2.
REMOVE REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and engine under cover
assembly.
3.
REMOVE NO.1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 engine under cover
sub-assembly.
4.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
5.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-14)
6.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (See page AH14)
7.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
8.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SP-28)
9.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
10. SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page
BC-211)
11. SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
12. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See
page PS-20)
13. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH (See
page PS-20)
14. REMOVE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page SP-22)
15. REMOVE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
16. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-5)
17. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH (See
page DS-5)
DF
DF–16
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
C097020E05
18. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the front differential
breather tube bracket.
(b) Support the front differential with a jack.
(c) Remove the front differential mount nut No. 1.
(d) Remove the 2 front mounting bolts and 2 nuts.
(e) Disconnect the actuator hose and connector.
(f) Lower the jack and remove the front differential
assembly.
(g) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 3 front differential
support.
(h) Remove the 5 bolts and 2 front differential supports.
DISASSEMBLY
DF
1.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Using a hammer, handle, remove the actuator
assembly.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, remove the differential
tube.
3.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
G023135
G023134
SST
R013209E01
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–17
4.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR INTER SHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the side gear inter shaft.
SST 09350-20015 (09369-20040), 09950-40011
(09951-04010, 09952-04010, 09953-04020,
09954-04010, 09955-04011, 09957-04010,
09958-04011)
(b) Remove the snap ring from the side gear inter shaft.
5.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and a hammer, remove the nut.
SST 09930-00010
SST
G023136E02
SST
F044234E01
(b) Using SST to hold the companion flange, remove
the nut.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030)
SST
SA02349E05
(c) Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
SST
F052175E01
6.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal from the differential
carrier assembly.
SST 09308-10010
7.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
SST
SA02348E03
DF
DF–18
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
8.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the rear bearing from the drive
pinion.
SST 09556-22010
(b) Remove the bearing spacer.
9.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the union.
(b) Remove the 10 bolts and tap out the side bearing
retainer with a plastic hammer.
SST
Z000641E04
10. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
11. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
12. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the front bearing
and washer from the drive pinion.
SST 09950-00020
HINT:
If the drive gear or ring gear is damaged, replace
them as a set.
DF
SST
R002482E02
13. REMOVE FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the front
bearing outer race.
R013226
14. REMOVE REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using SST, remove the rear bearing outer race.
SST 09502-12010, 09612-65014 (09612-01020,
09612-01050)
(b) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the oil
storage ring.
SST
F044257E01
15. REMOVE SIDE BEARING OUTER RACE
HINT:
• Measure the plate washer and note its thickness.
• Tag the bearing outer races to show the location for
reassembly.
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–19
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the outer race and
plate washer from the bearing retainer.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00680), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
SST
R013211E01
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the outer race and
plate washer from the differential carrier assembly.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00680), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
SST
R013213E01
SST
SST
R011392E02
RA00997
16. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on the ring gear and differential
case assembly.
(b) Remove the 10 bolts.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap on the ring gear to
separate it from the differential case assembly.
17. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the 2 differential case bearings
from the differential case assembly.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00390), 09950-40011
(09951-04020, 09952-04010, 09953-04030,
09954-04010, 09955-04061, 09957-04010,
09958-04011)
HINT:
Fix the claws of SST into the notch in the differential
case assembly.
18. DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove the
straight pin.
(b) Remove these parts from the differential case
assembly.
(1) 2 Differential side gears
(2) 2 Differential side gear thrust washers
(3) Differential pinion shaft
(4) 2 Differential pinion gears
(5) 2 Differential pinion gear thrust washers
19. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL GEAR KIT
(a) Check that there is no damage to the pinion gear
and side gear.
If the pinion gear and/or side gear is damaged,
replace the differential gear kit.
20. INSPECT FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Check that the differential case assembly is not
damaged.
If the differential case assembly is damaged,
replace it.
DF
DF–20
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
21. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the 2
bearings.
SA00353
22. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CLUTCH HUB
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the differential clutch hub.
DF
G023137
23. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal from the differential
tube.
SST 09308-00010
SST
R013199E01
24. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the side gear shaft from the differential
tube.
C097022
25. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
RH BEARING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Using SST, a brass bar and a press, remove the
bearing.
SST 09950-00020
NOTICE:
Do not damage the bearing.
SST
R013420E02
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–21
26. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
(a) Using SST, a socket wrench and a press, remove
the dust deflector.
SST 09950-00020
SST
R004465E01
27. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
DIFFERENTIAL CLUTCH HUB
(a) Check for wear and damage to the clutch hub and
clutch sleeve.
If necessary, replace them.
(b) Check that the clutch sleeve slides smoothly on the
clutch hub.
G023141
28. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR INTER SHAFT
(a) Check for wear and damage to the clutch hub and
side gear inter shaft.
(b) Check that the clutch sleeve slides smoothly on the
side gear inter shaft.
G023144
29. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CLUTCH SLEEVE AND
CLUTCH SLEEVE FORK CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the sleeve fork and clutch sleeve.
Maximum clearance:
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the
fork or clutch sleeve.
G023142
INSPECTION
1.
SST
R012683E03
INSPECT BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Using SST and a dial indicator, measure the ring
gear backlash.
SST 09564-32011
Backlash:
0.11 to 0.18 mm (0.0043 to 0.0071 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust
or repair the side bearing preload as necessary.
DF
DF–22
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
2.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Torque: 0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to
6.9 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential assembly.
3.
INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with
the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.20 to 0.63 N*m (2.0
to 6.4 kgf*cm, 1.8 to 5.6 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
FA01158
DF
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
(a) Using a steel plate and a press, install a new dust
deflector.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the dust deflector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
RH BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the bearing.
SST 09223-00010
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
3.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the side gear shaft into the differential tube.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
Steel Plate
G022166E01
SST
R013421E02
C097022
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–23
4.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST and a plastic hammer, install a new oil
seal.
SST 09608-32010
Oil seal drive in depth:
4.8 to 5.8 mm (0.1890 to 0.2284 in.)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
5.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CLUTCH HUB
(a) Install the clutch hub onto the side gear inter shaft.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
NOTICE:
Be sure to install the differential clutch hub in
the correct direction.
SST
R013419E01
G023138
6.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install 2 new bearings.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00380)
Bearing press in depth:
1.4 to 2.0 mm (0.055 to 0.079 in.)
7.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the 2 proper thrust washers onto the 2 side
gears.
HINT:
Using the table below, select the thrust washer
which will ensure that the backlash is within the
specifications.
Washer thickness
SST
SA00355E02
FA01121
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.48 to 1.52 (0.0583 to 0.0598)
1.73 to 1.77 (0.0681 to 0.0697)
1.53 to 1.57 (0.0602 to 0.0618)
1.78 to 1.82 (0.0701 to 0.0717)
1.58 to 1.62 (0.0622 to 0.0638)
1.83 to 1.87 (0.0720 to 0.0736)
1.63 to 1.67 (0.0642 to 0.0657)
1.88 to 1.92 (0.0740 to 0.0756)
1.68 to 1.72 (0.0661 to 0.0677)
-
(b) Install the 2 side gears, 2 side gear thrust washers,
2 pinion gears, 2 pinion gear thrust washers and
pinion shaft into the differential case assembly.
HINT:
Align the holes of the differential case assembly and
pinion shaft.
DF
DF–24
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(c) Measure the side gear backlash.
(1) Using a dial indicator, measure the side gear
backlash while holding one pinion gear toward
the differential case assembly.
Backlash:
0 to 0.15 mm (0 to 0.0059 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification,
install a side gear thrust washer with a different
thickness.
F043636
(d) Using a pin punch and hammer, install the straight
pin through the differential case assembly and hole
of the pinion shaft.
(e) Stake the differential case assembly.
DF
FA01124
8.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case
assembly and ring gear.
(b) Heat the ring gear to about 100°C (212°F) in boiling
water.
(c) Carefully take the ring gear out of the boiling water.
(d) After any moisture on the ring gear has completely
evaporated, quickly install the ring gear onto the
differential case assembly.
HINT:
Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and
differential case assembly.
(e) Temporarily install 10 bolts so that the bolt holes in
the ring gear and differential case assembly are
aligned.
(f) After the ring gear has cooled sufficiently, tighten the
ring gear set bolts to which thread lock has been
applied.
Torque: 97 N*m (985 kgf*cm, 71 ft.*lbf)
Thread lock:
Part No. 08833-00100, THREE BOND 1360k or
equivalent
9.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the 2 differential case
bearings into the differential case assembly.
SST 09226-10010
Boiling
Water
SA02160E02
SST
R013784E01
10. INSTALL SIDE BEARING OUTER RACE
HINT:
When replacing the 2 differential case bearings, fit 2 of
the thinnest new washers to each bearing and when
reusing the bearings, fit washers of the same thickness
as those removed.
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–25
(a) Install a new plate washer to the side bearing
retainer.
(b) Using SST and a press, install the bearing outer
race onto the differential case bearing retainer
assembly.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00810), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
(c) Install a new plate washer onto the differential
carrier assembly.
SST
R013375E02
(d) Using SST and a press, install the bearing outer
race onto the differential carrier assembly.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00810), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
SST
R013376E02
11. INSTALL FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using SST, install the outer race.
SST 09950-00020 (09951-00680, 09951-00890)
SST
Front:
12. INSTALL REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Install the oil storage ring.
(b) Using SST, install the outer race.
SST 09950-00020 (09951-00680, 09951-00890)
13. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Install the washer onto the drive pinion.
HINT:
First, fit a washer of the same thickness as the
removed washer, then after checking the tooth
contact pattern, replace the washer with one of a
differential thickness if necessary.
Rear:
R013281E02
DF
DF–26
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(b) Using SST and a press, install the front bearing onto
the drive pinion.
SST 09506-30012
SST
14. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Install the drive pinion.
HINT:
Assemble the spacer and oil seal after adjusting the
ring gear tooth contact pattern.
R001197E01
(b) Using SST, install the rear bearing, oil slinger and
companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
(c) Coat the threads of the nut with hypoid gear oil.
SST
DF
SST
R011163E05
(d) Adjust the drive pinion preload by tightening the
companion flange nut.
(e) Using SST to hold the companion flange, tighten the
nut.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030)
NOTICE:
As there is no spacer, tighten the nut a little at a
time, being careful not to overtighten it.
SST
SA02347E03
(f)
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting)
Bearing
Standard
New
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (10 to 16 kgf*cm, 8.7 to 13.9 in.*lbf)
Reused
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to 6.9 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential assembly.
SA02352
15. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
16. ADJUST BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Install the side bearing retainer with the 10 bolts.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
SST
R012683E03
DF–27
(b) Using SST and a dial indicator, measure the ring
gear backlash.
SST 09564-32011
Backlash:
0.11 to 0.18 mm (0.0043 to 0.0071 in.)
(c) If it is not within the specification, adjust it by either
increasing or decreasing the thickness of the
washers on both sides by an equal amount.
HINT:
There should be no clearance between the plate
washer and differential case.
Make sure that there is ring gear backlash.
Washer thickness
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.59 to 1.61 (0.0626 to 0.0634)
1.89 to 1.91 (0.0744 to 0.0752)
2.19 to 2.21 (0.0862 to 0.0870)
1.62 to 1.64 (0.0638 to 0.0646)
1.92 to 1.94 (0.0756 to 0.0764)
2.22 to 2.24 (0.0874 to 0.0882)
1.65 to 1.67 (0.0650 to 0.0657)
1.95 to 1.97 (0.0768 to 0.0776)
2.25 to 2.27 (0.0886 to 0.0894)
1.68 to 1.70 (0.0661 to 0.0669)
1.98 to 2.00 (0.0780 to 0.0787)
2.28 to 2.30 (0.0898 to 0.0906)
1.71 to 1.73 (0.0673 to 0.0681)
2.01 to 2.03 (0.0791 to 0.0800)
2.31 to 2.33 (0.0909 to 0.0917)
1.74 to 1.76 (0.0685 to 0.0693)
2.04 to 2.06 (0.0803 to 0.0811)
2.34 to 2.36 (0.0921 to 0.0929)
1.77 to 1.79 (0.0697 to 0.0705)
2.07 to 2.09 (0.0815 to 0.0823)
2.37 to 2.39 (0.0933 to 0.0941)
1.80 to 1.82 (0.0709 to 0.0717)
2.10 to 2.12 (0.0827 to 0.0835)
2.40 to 2.42 (0.0945 to 0.0953)
1.83 to 1.85 (0.0720 to 0.0728)
2.13 to 2.15 (0.0839 to 0.0846)
2.43 to 2.45 (0.0957 to 0.0965)
1.86 to 1.88 (0.0732 to 0.0740)
2.16 to 2.18 (0.0850 to 0.0858)
2.46 to 2.48 (0.0969 to 0.0976)
17. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with
the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.20 to 0.63 N*m (2.0
to 6.4 kgf*cm, 1.8 to 5.6 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
SA02352
18. INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVE PINION
(a) Remove the side bearing retainer and differential
case assembly.
(b) Coat 3 or 4 teeth at 3 different positions on the ring
gear with red lead.
(c) Install the differential case assembly and side
bearing retainer.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(d) Hold the companion flange firmly and rotate the ring
gear in both directions.
(e) Remove the differential case, side bearing retainer
and differential case assembly.
R013220
DF
DF–28
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(f)
Inspect the tooth contact pattern.
Washer
FA02008E01
DF
Heel Contact
Face Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will bring the drive
pinion closer to the ring gear.
Proper Contact
Toe Contact
Flank Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will shift the drive pinion
away from the ring gear.
Z000699E01
If the teeth are not engaged properly, use the
following chart to select the appropriate washer for
correction.
Washer thickness
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.69 to 1.71 (0.0665 to 0.0673)
1.93 to 1.95 (0.0760 to 0.0768)
2.17 to 2.19 (0.0854 to 0.0862)
1.72 to 1.74 (0.0677 to 0.0685)
1.96 to 1.98 (0.0772 to 0.0780)
2.20 to 2.22 (0.0866 to 0.0874)
1.75 to 1.77 (0.0689 to 0.0697)
1.99 to 2.01 (0.0783 to 0.0791)
2.23 to 2.25 (0.0878 to 0.0886)
1.78 to 1.80 (0.0701 to 0.0709)
2.02 to 2.04 (0.0795 to 0.0803)
2.26 to 2.28 (0.0890 to 0.0898)
1.81 to 1.83 (0.0713 to 0.0720)
2.05 to 2.07 (0.0807 to 0.0815)
2.29 to 2.31 (0.0902 to 0.0909)
1.84 to 1.86 (0.0724 to 0.0732)
2.08 to 2.10 (0.0819 to 0.0827)
2.32 to 2.34 (0.0913 to 0.0921)
1.87 to 1.89 (0.0736 to 0.0744)
2.11 to 2.13 (0.0831 to 0.0839)
-
1.90 to 1.92 (0.0748 to 0.0756)
2.14 to 2.16 (0.0843 to 0.0850)
-
(g) Using SST, remove the companion flange and oil
slinger.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030), 09950-30012
(09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010,
09955-03030, 09956-03020)
(h) Using SST, remove the rear bearing from the drive
pinion.
SST 09556-22010
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–29
19. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
BEARING SPACER
(a) Install a new bearing spacer and oil storage ring.
20. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
21. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
22. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Place the companion flange on the drive pinion.
(b) Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil
LSD.
(c) Using SST and the companion flange, install the
rear tapered roller bearing, then remove the
companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
SST
SST
R011163E06
23. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, install the oil seal.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030), 09554-22010
Oil seal drive in depth:
3.9 to 4.8 mm (0.153 to 0.189 in.)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
SST
R013417E02
(c) Using SST to hold the flange, tighten the nut.
Torque: 370 N*m (3,770 kgf*cm, 273 ft.*lbf)
SST
SA02351E05
DF
DF–30
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
FIPG
R013200E02
DF
24. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
(a) Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to
drop oil on the contact surfaces of the differential
carrier and side bearing retainer.
(b) Clean the contact surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
(c) Apply FIPG to the side bearing retainer, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
HINT:
Install the side bearing retainer within 10 minutes of
applying FIPG.
(d) Install the side bearing retainer with the 10 bolts.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the union.
25. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting)
SA02352
Bearing
Standard
New
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (10 to 16 kgf*cm, 8.7 to 13.9 in.*lbf)
Reused
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to 6.9 in.*lbf)
If the preload is greater than the specification,
replace the bearing spacer.
If the preload is less than the specification, retighten
the nut to 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft*lbf) a little at a
time until the specified preload is reached.
Torque: 370 N*m (3,773 kgf*cm, 273 ft.*lbf) or
less
If the maximum torque is exceeded while
retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repair the preload procedure. Do not loosen the nut
to reduce the preload.
26. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
27. INSPECT BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
SST 09564-32011
28. INSPECT FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY FRONT
29. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE FRONT NUT
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–31
30. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST and a plastic hammer, install a new oil
seal until its surface is flush with the differential
carrier end.
SST 09608-32010
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
Oil seal driven in depth:
-0.45 to 0.45 mm (-0.0177 to 0.0177 in.)
SST
F044255E01
31. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR INTER SHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new snap ring onto the side gear inter shaft.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, install the side gear inter
shaft onto the differential case.
(c) Check that there are 2 to 3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.) of
play in the axial direction.
(d) Check that the side gear inter shaft will not come out
by trying to pull it completely out by hand.
G023139
32. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING
RETAINER DEFLECTOR
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install the side
bearing retainer deflector.
NOTICE:
Be sure to install the side bearing retainer
deflector in the correct direction.
G023145
FIPG
F044256E01
33. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to
drop oil on the contact surfaces of the differential
and clutch case.
(b) Clean the contact surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
(c) Apply FIPG to the differential, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
HINT:
Install the differential tube within 10 minutes of
applying FIPG.
(d) Install the differential tube into the differential carrier
assembly.
DF
DF–32
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(e) Clean the threads of the 4 bolts and retainer bolt
holes with toluene or trichloroethylene.
(f) Apply adhesive to 2 to 3 threads of each bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(g) Install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf) or
less
G023134
DF
G023140
34. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to
drop oil on the contact surfaces of the actuator and
clutch case.
(b) Clean the contact surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
(c) Apply FIPG to the differential tube, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
HINT:
Install the actuator within 10 minutes of applying
FIPG.
(d) Clean the threads of the 4 bolts and retainer bolt
holes with toluene or trichloroethylene.
(e) Install the actuator assembly onto the differential
tube.
(f) Apply adhesive to 2 to 3 threads of each bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
(g) Install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 21 N*m (210 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
G023143
INSTALLATION
1.
C097020
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the actuator hose and connector.
(b) Install the No. 1 mounting support with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 186 N*m (1,900 kgf*cm, 137 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the No. 2 mounting support with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 160 N*m (1,630 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the No. 3 front differential support with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 108 N*m (1,100 kgf*cm, 80 ft.*lbf)
(e) Support the front differential with a jack.
(f) Install the 2 front mounting bolts and nuts.
Torque: 137 N*m (1,400 kgf*cm, 101 ft.*lbf)
(g) Install the No. 1 front differential mount nut.
Torque: 87 N*m (887 kgf*cm, 64 ft.*lbf)
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–33
(h) Install the front differential breather tube bracket
with the bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(i) Lower the jack.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-9)
3.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page AH-17)
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
6.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See
page PS-34)
7.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH (See
page PS-34)
8.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page BC211)
9.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
10. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SP-29)
11. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
12. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (See page AH17)
13. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
14. INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-19)
15. FILL UP DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
16. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
17. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 engine under cover sub-assembly
with the 4 bolts.
18. INSTALL REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the engine under cover assembly rear with
the 6 bolts.
19. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
DF
DF–34
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
20. INSPECT CHECK ABS SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
DF
DF–42
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
3.
INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with
the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.25 to 0.45 N*m (2.5
to 4.6 kgf*cm, 2.2 to 4.0 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
(a) Using a steel plate and a press, install a new dust
deflector.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the dust deflector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
RH BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the bearing.
SST 09223-00010
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
3.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the side gear shaft into the differential tube.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
4.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST and a plastic hammer, install a new oil
seal.
SST 09608-32010
Oil seal drive in depth:
4.8 to 5.8 mm (0.1890 to 0.2284 in.)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
Steel Plate
DF
G022166E01
SST
R013421E02
C097022
SST
R013419E01
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
5.
FA01121
DF–43
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the 2 proper thrust washers onto the 2 side
gears.
HINT:
Using the table below, select the thrust washer
which will ensure that the backlash is within the
specifications.
Washer thickness
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.48 to 1.52 (0.0583 to 0.0598)
1.73 to 1.77 (0.0681 to 0.0697)
1.53 to 1.57 (0.0602 to 0.0618)
1.78 to 1.82 (0.0701 to 0.0717)
1.58 to 1.62 (0.0622 to 0.0638)
1.83 to 1.87 (0.0720 to 0.0736)
1.63 to 1.67 (0.0642 to 0.0657)
1.88 to 1.92 (0.0740 to 0.0756)
1.68 to 1.72 (0.0661 to 0.0677)
-
(b) Install the 2 side gears, 2 side gear thrust washers,
2 pinion gears, 2 pinion gear thrust washers and
pinion shaft into the differential case assembly.
HINT:
Align the holes of the differential case assembly and
pinion shaft.
(c) Measure the side gear backlash.
(1) Using a dial indicator, measure the side gear
backlash while holding one pinion gear toward
the differential case assembly.
Backlash:
0 to 0.15 mm (0 to 0.0059 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification,
install a side gear thrust washer with a different
thickness.
F043636
(d) Using a pin punch and hammer, install the straight
pin through the differential case assembly and hole
of the pinion shaft.
(e) Stake the differential case assembly.
FA01124
6.
Boiling
Water
SA02160E02
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case
assembly and ring gear.
(b) Heat the ring gear to about 100°C (212°F) in boiling
water.
(c) Carefully take the ring gear out of the boiling water.
DF
DF–44
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(d) After any moisture on the ring gear has completely
evaporated, quickly install the ring gear onto the
differential case assembly.
HINT:
Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and
differential case assembly.
(e) Temporarily install 5 new lock plates and 10 bolts so
that the bolt holes in the ring gear and differential
case assembly are aligned.
(f) After the ring gear has cooled sufficiently, tighten the
ring gear set bolts to which thread lock has been
applied.
Torque: 97 N*m (985 kgf*cm, 71 ft.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the 2 differential case
bearings into the differential case assembly.
SST 09226-10010
8.
INSTALL SIDE BEARING OUTER RACE
HINT:
When replacing the 2 differential case bearings, fit 2 of
the thinnest new washers to each bearing and when
reusing the bearings, fit washers of the same thickness
as those removed.
(a) Install a new plate washer to the side bearing
retainer.
DF
SST
R013784E01
(b) Using SST and a press, install the bearing outer
race onto the differential case bearing retainer
assembly.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00810), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
(c) Install a new plate washer onto the differential
carrier assembly.
SST
R013375E02
(d) Using SST and a press, install the bearing outer
race onto the differential carrier assembly.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00810), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
SST
R013376E02
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
9.
SST
Front:
DF–45
INSTALL FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using SST, install the outer race.
SST 09950-00020 (09951-00680, 09951-00890)
10. INSTALL REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Install the oil storage ring.
(b) Using SST, install the outer race.
SST 09950-00020 (09951-00680, 09951-00890)
11. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Install the washer onto the drive pinion.
HINT:
First, fit a washer of the same thickness as the
removed washer, then after checking the tooth
contact pattern, replace the washer with one of a
differential thickness if necessary.
Rear:
R013281E02
(b) Using SST and a press, install the front bearing onto
the drive pinion.
SST 09506-30012
SST
12. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Install the drive pinion.
HINT:
Assemble the spacer and oil seal after adjusting the
ring gear tooth contact pattern.
R001197E01
(b) Using SST, install the rear bearing, oil slinger and
companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
(c) Coat the threads of the nut with hypoid gear oil.
SST
SST
R011163E05
(d) Adjust the drive pinion preload by tightening the
companion flange nut.
(e) Using SST to hold the companion flange, tighten the
nut.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030)
NOTICE:
As there is no spacer, tighten the nut a little at a
time, being careful not to overtighten it.
SST
SA02347E03
DF
DF–46
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(f)
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting)
Bearing
Standard
New
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (10 to 16 kgf*cm, 8.7 to 13.9 in.*lbf)
Reused
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to 6.9 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential assembly.
SA02352
13. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
14. ADJUST BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Install the side bearing retainer with the 10 bolts.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
DF
SST
R012683E03
(b) Using SST and a dial indicator, measure the ring
gear backlash.
SST 09564-32011
Backlash:
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
(c) If it is not within the specification, adjust it by either
increasing or decreasing the thickness of the
washers on both sides by an equal amount.
HINT:
There should be no clearance between the plate
washer and differential case.
Make sure that there is ring gear backlash.
Washer thickness
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.59 to 1.61 (0.0626 to 0.0634)
1.89 to 1.91 (0.0744 to 0.0752)
2.19 to 2.21 (0.0862 to 0.0870)
1.62 to 1.64 (0.0638 to 0.0646)
1.92 to 1.94 (0.0756 to 0.0764)
2.22 to 2.24 (0.0874 to 0.0882)
1.65 to 1.67 (0.0650 to 0.0657)
1.95 to 1.97 (0.0768 to 0.0776)
2.25 to 2.27 (0.0886 to 0.0894)
1.68 to 1.70 (0.0661 to 0.0669)
1.98 to 2.00 (0.0780 to 0.0787)
2.28 to 2.30 (0.0898 to 0.0906)
1.71 to 1.73 (0.0673 to 0.0681)
2.01 to 2.03 (0.0791 to 0.0800)
2.31 to 2.33 (0.0909 to 0.0917)
1.74 to 1.76 (0.0685 to 0.0693)
2.04 to 2.06 (0.0803 to 0.0811)
2.34 to 2.36 (0.0921 to 0.0929)
1.77 to 1.79 (0.0697 to 0.0705)
2.07 to 2.09 (0.0815 to 0.0823)
2.37 to 2.39 (0.0933 to 0.0941)
1.80 to 1.82 (0.0709 to 0.0717)
2.10 to 2.12 (0.0827 to 0.0835)
2.40 to 2.42 (0.0945 to 0.0953)
1.83 to 1.85 (0.0720 to 0.0728)
2.13 to 2.15 (0.0839 to 0.0846)
2.43 to 2.45 (0.0957 to 0.0965)
1.86 to 1.88 (0.0732 to 0.0740)
2.16 to 2.18 (0.0850 to 0.0858)
2.46 to 2.48 (0.0969 to 0.0976)
15. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with
the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.25 to 0.45 N*m (2.5
to 4.6 kgf*cm, 2.2 to 4.0 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
SA02352
16. INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVE PINION
(a) Remove the side bearing retainer and differential
case assembly.
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–47
(b) Coat 3 or 4 teeth at 3 different positions on the ring
gear with red lead.
(c) Install the differential case assembly and side
bearing retainer.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(d) Hold the companion flange firmly and rotate the ring
gear in both directions.
(e) Remove the differential case, side bearing retainer
and differential case assembly.
R013220
(f)
Inspect the tooth contact pattern.
DF
Washer
FA02008E01
Heel Contact
Face Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will bring the drive
pinion closer to the ring gear.
Proper Contact
Toe Contact
Flank Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will shift the drive pinion
away from the ring gear.
Z000699E01
If the teeth are not engaged properly, use the
following chart to select the appropriate washer for
correction.
Washer thickness
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.69 to 1.71 (0.0665 to 0.0673)
1.93 to 1.95 (0.0760 to 0.0768)
2.17 to 2.19 (0.0854 to 0.0862)
1.72 to 1.74 (0.0677 to 0.0685)
1.96 to 1.98 (0.0772 to 0.0780)
2.20 to 2.22 (0.0866 to 0.0874)
1.75 to 1.77 (0.0689 to 0.0697)
1.99 to 2.01 (0.0783 to 0.0791)
2.23 to 2.25 (0.0878 to 0.0886)
1.78 to 1.80 (0.0701 to 0.0709)
2.02 to 2.04 (0.0795 to 0.0803)
2.26 to 2.28 (0.0890 to 0.0898)
1.81 to 1.83 (0.0713 to 0.0720)
2.05 to 2.07 (0.0807 to 0.0815)
2.29 to 2.31 (0.0902 to 0.0909)
1.84 to 1.86 (0.0724 to 0.0732)
2.08 to 2.10 (0.0819 to 0.0827)
2.32 to 2.34 (0.0913 to 0.0921)
DF–48
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.87 to 1.89 (0.0736 to 0.0744)
2.11 to 2.13 (0.0831 to 0.0839)
-
1.90 to 1.92 (0.0748 to 0.0756)
2.14 to 2.16 (0.0843 to 0.0850)
-
(g) Using SST, remove the companion flange and oil
slinger.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030), 09950-30012
(09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010,
09955-03030, 09956-03020)
(h) Using SST, remove the rear bearing from the drive
pinion.
SST 09556-22010
17. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
BEARING SPACER
(a) Install a new bearing spacer and oil storage ring.
DF
18. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
19. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
20. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Place the companion flange on the drive pinion.
(b) Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil
LSD.
(c) Using SST and the companion flange, install the
rear tapered roller bearing, then remove the
companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
SST
SST
R011163E06
21. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, install the oil seal.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030), 09554-22010
Oil seal drive in depth:
3.9 to 4.8 mm (0.153 to 0.189 in.)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
SST
R013417E02
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–49
(c) Using SST to hold the flange, tighten the nut.
Torque: 370 N*m (3,770 kgf*cm, 273 ft.*lbf)
SST
SA02351E05
FIPG
R013200E02
22. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
(a) Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to
drop oil on the contact surfaces of the differential
carrier and side bearing retainer.
(b) Clean the contact surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
(c) Apply FIPG to the side bearing retainer, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
HINT:
Install the side bearing retainer within 10 minutes of
applying FIPG.
(d) Install the side bearing retainer with the 10 bolts.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the union.
23. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting)
SA02352
Bearing
Standard
New
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (10 to 16 kgf*cm, 8.7 to 13.9 in.*lbf)
Reused
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to 6.9 in.*lbf)
If the preload is greater than the specification,
replace the bearing spacer.
If the preload is less than the specification, retighten
the nut to 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft*lbf) a little at a
time until the specified preload is reached.
Torque: 370 N*m (3,773 kgf*cm, 273 ft.*lbf) or
less
If the maximum torque is exceeded while
retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repair the preload procedure. Do not loosen the nut
to reduce the preload.
24. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
25. INSPECT BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
SST 09564-32011
26. INSPECT FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY FRONT
DF
DF–50
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
27. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE FRONT NUT
28. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST and a plastic hammer, install a new oil
seal until its surface is flush with the differential
carrier end.
SST 09608-32010
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
Oil seal driven in depth:
-0.45 to 0.45 mm (-0.0177 to 0.0177 in.)
SST
F044255E01
DF
FIPG
F044256E01
29. INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to
drop oil on the contact surfaces of the differential
and clutch case.
(b) Clean the contact surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
(c) Apply FIPG to the differential, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
HINT:
Install the differential tube within 10 minutes of
applying FIPG.
(d) Install the differential tube into the differential carrier
assembly.
(e) Clean the threads of the 4 bolts and retainer bolt
holes with toluene or trichloroethylene.
(f) Apply adhesive to 2 to 3 threads of each bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(g) Install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf) or
less
G023134
INSTALLATION
1.
C097020
INSTALL FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 mounting support with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 186 N*m (1,900 kgf*cm, 137 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the No. 2 mounting support with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 160 N*m (1,630 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the No. 3 front differential support with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 108 N*m (1,100 kgf*cm, 80 ft.*lbf)
(d) Support the front differential with a jack.
(e) Install the 2 front mounting bolts and nuts.
Torque: 137 N*m (1,400 kgf*cm, 101 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the No. 1 front differential mount nut.
Torque: 87 N*m (887 kgf*cm, 64 ft.*lbf)
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–51
(g) Install the front differential breather tube bracket
with the bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(h) Lower the jack.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-9)
3.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page SP-26)
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER RH
6.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See
page PS-34)
7.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH (See
page PS-34)
8.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page BC211)
9.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
10. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SP-29)
11. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
12. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (See page AH17)
13. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
14. INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-19)
15. FILL UP DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
16. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
17. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 engine under cover sub-assembly
with the 4 bolts.
18. INSTALL REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the engine under cover assembly rear with
the 6 bolts.
19. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
DF
DF–52
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
20. INSPECT CHECK ABS SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
DF
DIFFERENTIAL – DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM
DF–1
DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
Before disassembly, clean the outside of the front
and rear differential assembly and remove any sand
and mud to prevent it from entering the assembly
during disassembly and installation.
2. When removing connected parts made of a light
alloy, such as front and rear differential carrier
covers, tap them off with a plastic hammer. Do not
attempt to pry them off with a screwdriver.
3. Always arrange disassembled parts in order and
protect them from dust.
4. Before installation, thoroughly clean and dry each
part and then apply hypoid gear oil LSD to it. Do not
use alkaline cleaner for aluminum or rubber parts
and ring gear set bolts. Also, do not clean rubber
parts such as O-rings or oil seals with white
gasoline.
5. Coat all sliding surfaces and rotating parts with
hypoid gear oil LSD.
6. When holding components in a vice, be sure to place
an aluminum sheet under the M part. Do not put
them directly in the vice.
7. Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
case. Such damage could cause oil leakage.
8. Before applying sealant, remove any deposited oil
sealant and clean the part to be sealed using white
gasoline.
9. Do not supply oil immediately after installing sealed
parts. Leave them for at least an hour.
10. Damage to the surfaces in direct contact with oil
seals, O-rings or gaskets could cause oil leakage.
Special attention should be paid.
11. When press-fitting an oil seal, be careful not to
damage the oil seal lip and outside periphery.
12. When replacing a bearing, replace the inner and
outer races as a set.
DF
DF–2
DIFFERENTIAL – DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem.
The numbers indicate the ranked order of probability of each
of the possible causes. Check each part in order. If
necessary, replace these parts.
DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM
Symptom
Oil leakage from front differential
DF
Oil leakage from rear differential
Oil leak from front drive pinion shaft
Oil leak from rear drive pinion shaft
Suspected area
See page
1. Oil level (Too high or wrong grade)
DF-3
2. Front differential rear oil seal (Worn or damaged)
DF-6
3. Companion flange (Loose or damaged) (1GR-FE)
DF-29
4. Companion flange (Loose or damaged) (2UZ-FE)
DF-48
1. Oil level (Too high or wrong grade)
DF-3
2. Rear differential front oil seal (Worn or damaged)
DF-5
3. Companion flange (Loose or damaged)
DF-57
1. Oil level (Too high or wrong grade)
DF-3
2. Front differential rear oil seal (Worn or damaged)
DF-6
3. Companion flange (Loose or damaged) (1GR-FE)
DF-29
4. Companion flange (Loose or damaged) (2UZ-FE)
DF-48
1. Oil level (Too high or wrong grade)
DF-3
2. Rear differential front oil seal (Worn or damaged)
DF-6
3. Companion flange (Loose or damaged)
DF-71
DF–56
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
See procedure
Vehicle Type
Proceed to
2WD
PR-3
4WD
PR-8
3.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
4.
SEPARATE REAR SPEED SENSOR LH (See page BC213)
5.
SEPARATE REAR SPEED SENSOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
6.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc
brake caliper assembly LH.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the disc
brake caliper assembly LH.
7.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc
brake caliper assembly RH.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the disc
brake caliper assembly RH.
8.
REMOVE REAR DISC (See page BR-46)
9.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN
TENSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
DF
10. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
11. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
12. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE
13. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT WITH BACKING
PLATE (See page AH-24)
14. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 10 nuts, 10 washers and differential
carrier assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of
the differential carrier and rear axle housing.
C030284
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–57
DISASSEMBLY
30 mm (1.18 in.)
1.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER GASKET
2.
FIX REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
3.
INSPECT RUNOUT OF REAR DRIVE PINION
COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the
companion flange vertically and horizontally.
Maximum runout:
Vertical runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Lateral runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the runouts are not with the specifications, replace
the companion flange.
4.
INSPECT RUNOUT OF DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the runout of the ring
gear.
Maximum runout:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace
the ring gear with a new one.
5.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR BACKLASH
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash of the ring
gear.
Backlash:
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust
or repair the side bearing preload as necessary.
6.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting):
0.56 to 0.85 N*m (5.7 to 8.7 kgf*cm, 5.0 to 7.5
in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential assembly.
HINT:
Before measurement, rotate the ring gear 5 times or
more.
F001237E03
C014075
C028211
C003092
DF
DF–58
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
7.
INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the total preload
with the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in
contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.39 to 0.59 N*m (4.0
to 6.0 kgf*cm, 3.5 to 5.2 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
8.
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
(a) 2WD drive type:
Using a "Torx" socket (E10), remove the 4 stud
bolts.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, unstake nut.
SST 09930-00010
C003092
DF
SST
F044346E02
(c) Using SST to hold the drive pinion companion
flange, remove the nut.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030)
SST
SA02349E06
9.
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using SST, remove the drive pinion companion
flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03030)
SST
F052175E02
10. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal from the differential
carrier.
SST 09308-10010
SST
11. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
SA02348E03
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–59
12. REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the front bearing from the drive
pinion.
SST 09556-22010
SST
Z000641E04
13. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL BEARING
ADJUSTING NUT LOCK
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 rear differential bearing
adjusting nut locks.
C030538
14. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the bearing cap and
differential carrier.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and 2 differential bearing caps.
(c) Remove the 2 adjusting nuts.
Matchmarks
C030539E03
(d) Remove the rear differential case assembly and 2
bearing outer races from the differential carrier
assembly.
HINT:
Tag the 2 bearings outer races to show the locations
for reassembly.
C028220
15. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Remove the differential drive pinion and bearing
spacer from the differential carrier assembly.
C030540
DF
DF–60
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
SST
R010668E02
16. REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the rear bearing
from the drive pinion.
SST 09950-00020
HINT:
If either the drive pinion or ring gear is damaged,
replace them as a set.
17. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
PLATE WASHER
(a) Remove the plate washer from the drive pinion.
18. REMOVE FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using a brass bar an a hammer, remove the front
bearing outer race from the differential carrier
assembly.
DF
19. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL OIL STORAGE RING
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the oil
storage ring.
C091046
20. REMOVE REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the rear
tapered roller bearing from the carrier.
C091047
21. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on the ring gear and differential
case assembly.
(b) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, unstake the 5
lock plates.
(c) Remove the 10 ring gear set bolts and 5 lock plates.
(d) Using a plastic hammer, tap on the ring gear to
separate it from the differential case assembly.
Matchmarks
W001777E01
22. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
RUNOUT
HINT:
It will be done only when it exceeds the limit at the ring
gear runout check.
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
C015154
SST
W002838E01
DF–61
(a) Install the differential case assembly to the
differential carrier assembly.
(b) Align the matchmarks, install the 2 bearing caps
with the 4 bolts to the differential carrier assembly.
Torque: 85 N*m (867 kgf*cm, 63 ft.*lbf)
(c) Inspect the differential case runout.
Maximum runout:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
(d) Remove the 4 bolts and bearing caps from the
differential carrier assembly.
(e) Remove the differential case assembly from the
differential carrier assembly.
23. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the 2 rear differential case
bearings from the differential case assembly.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04010, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04061,
09957-04010, 09958-04011), 09950-60010
(09951-00480), 09950-60020 (09951-00730)
HINT:
Fix the claws of SST to the notches in the
differential case assembly.
24. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the dust deflector.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00380), 09950-70010
(09951-07150), 09950-00020
SST
F040564E10
25. DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Place matchmarks on the LH and RH cases.
(b) Remove the 8 bolts uniformly, a little at a time.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, separate the LH and RH
cases.
Matchmarks
R014029E01
DF
DF–62
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
(d) Remove these parts from the differential case.
B
A
C
E
D
D
E
A
B
DF
C090324E02
A (2 pieces)
Side gear
B (2 pieces)
Side gear thrust washer
C
Spider
D (4 pieces)
Pinion gear
E (4 pieces)
Pinion gear thrust washer
26. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL PINION AND SIDE GEAR
(a) Check that there is no damage to the differential
pinion and differential side gear.
If the differential pinion and/or differential side gear
is damaged, replace the differential.
DIFFERENTIAL – DIFFERENTIAL OIL
DF–3
DIFFERENTIAL OIL
ADJUSTMENT
1.
0 to 5 mm
(0 to 0.20 in.)
D025304E03
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL
(a) Stop the vehicle on a level place.
(b) Remove the differential filler plug and gasket.
(c) Check that the oil level is within 5mm (0 to 0.20 in.)
of the bottom of the filler plug opening.
NOTICE:
• Excessively large or small quantities of oil
may cause problems.
• After replacing the oil, drive the vehicle and
check the oil level again.
HINT:
If necessary, fill the rear differential carrier assembly
with hypoid gear oil.
Oil grade:
Hypoid gear oil API GL-5
Recommended viscosity:
Above -18°C (0°F) SAE 90
Below -18°C (0°F) SAE 80W or 80W-90
Capacity:
Front differential carrier assembly:
1.35 to 1.45 litters
(1.43 to 1.53 US qts, 1.19 to 1.27 lmp. qts)
Rear differential carrier assembly
3.00 to 3.10 litters
(3.17 to 3.27 US qts, 2.64 to 2.72 lmp. qts)
(d) Check for oil leakage if the oil level is low.
(e) Install the differential filler plug and a new gasket.
Torque: Front differential carrier assembly
39 N*m (398 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
Rear differential carrier assembly
49 N*m (500 kgf*cm, 36 ft.*lbf)
DF
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–63
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Check that the differential case assembly is not
damaged.
If the differential case assembly is damaged,
replace the differential case assembly.
REASSEMBLY
Steel Plate
1.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
(a) Using SST, a press and a steel plate, install the dust
deflector.
SST 09636-20010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the dust deflector.
SST
DF
B053734E03
2.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear differential side gear thrust washer
onto the rear differential side gear.
(b) Install the 4 rear differential pinion thrust washers
and rear differential pinion gears onto the rear
differential spider.
(c) Fix the differential case RH.
ZK01881
(d) Install the rear differential side gear and rear
differential spider onto the differential case RH.
ZK09096
(e) Using a dial indicator, measure the differential case
RH side backlash while holding the pinion toward
the case.
Backlash:
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.002 to 0.008 in.)
(f) Remove the rear differential spider from the
differential case RH.
ZK09097
DF–64
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
(g) Install the rear differential side gear and rear
differential spider onto the differential case LH.
(h) Using a dial indicator, measure the differential case
LH side backlash while holding the pinion toward
the case.
HINT:
Measure at all 4 locations.
Backlash:
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.002 to 0.008 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, install
2 side gear thrust washers of a different thickness.
Thrust washer thickness
ZK09098
DF
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
0.9 (0.0354)
1.2 (0.0472)
1.0 (0.0394)
1.3 (0.0512)
1.1 (0.0433)
-
(i)
Install the differential side gear thrust washer to the
RH case.
(j) Install the differential pinion gears and differential
spider to the RH case.
(k) Install the differential side gear and differential side
gear thrust washer to the RH case.
W001779
(l)
Align the matchmarks and assemble the RH and LH
cases.
(m) Using a plastic hammer, install the RH and LH case.
(n) Install the 8 bolts.
Torque: 47 N*m (480 kgf*cm, 35 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
C089323E02
3.
SST
SST
R015935E01
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the 2 differential case
bearings onto the differential case assembly.
SST 09223-15020, 09950-60010 (09951-00480,
09951-00550), 09950-60020 (09951-00730)
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
4.
Boiling Water
DF–65
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case
assembly and ring gear.
(b) Heat the ring gear to approximately 100°C (212°F)
in boiling water.
(c) Carefully take the ring gear out of the boiling water.
(d) After the moisture on the ring gear has completely
evaporated, quickly install the ring gear onto the
differential case.
SA01143E02
(e) Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and
differential case assembly.
(f) Temporarily install 5 new lock plates and 10 set
bolts.
(g) After the ring gear cools down sufficiently, torque the
8 bolts uniformly at a time.
Torque: 97 N*m (985 kgf*cm, 71 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Tighten the bolts in diagonal order little by little in
several steps.
Matchmarks
W001777E01
(h) Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the 5 lock
plates.
HINT:
Stake one claw so that it is flush with the flat surface
of the bolt.
For the claw in contacting with the protruding portion
of the bolt, stake only the half on the tightening side.
W001781
5.
SA02465
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR RUNOUT
(a) Install the differential case onto the carrier, and
install the 2 adjusting nuts so that there is no play in
the bearing.
(b) Install the 2 bearing caps with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 85 N*m (867 kgf*cm, 63 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the 2 adjusting nut locks with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(d) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the ring
gear.
Maximum runout:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If it is not within the specification, replace the ring
gear.
(e) Remove the 2 bolts and adjusting nut locks.
(f) Remove the 2 bearing caps, 2 adjusting nuts and
differential case assembly.
DF
DF–66
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install a new oil
storage ring.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, install the front bearing
outer race to the differential carrier assembly.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00021)
7.
INSTALL REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using SST and a press, install the rear bearing
outer race to the differential carrier case.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00051)
8.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Install the plate washer onto the drive pinion.
(b) Using SST and a press, install the rear bearing onto
the drive pinion.
SST 09506-30012
9.
ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Install the drive pinion, front bearing and oil slinger.
HINT:
Assemble the spacer and oil seal after adjusting the
gear contact pattern.
SST
F044251E01
SST
DF
F044252E01
SST
SA03102E03
C028218
(b) Using SST, install the drive pinion companion
flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03030)
(c) Coat the threads of the nut with hypoid gear oil LSD.
SST
F052182E01
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–67
(d) Using SST to hold the drive pinion companion
flange, tighten the nut.
Torque: 215 N*m (2,190 kgf*cm, 159 ft.*lbf)
SST 09330-00021
NOTICE:
• As there is no spacer, tighten a little at a time,
being careful not to overtighten it.
• Apply hypoid gear oil LSD to the nut.
SST
C014066E02
(e) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting)
C003092
C028220
Bearing
Standard
New
1.05 to 1.64 N*m (10.7 to 16.7 kgf*cm, 9.3 to 14.5 in.*lbf)
Reused
0.56 to 0.85 N*m (5.7 to 8.7 kgf*cm, 5.0 to 7.5 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Measure the total preload after first turning the
bearing clockwise and counterclockwise several
times to make the bearing smooth.
10. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Place the 2 bearing outer races on their
corresponding bearings.
(b) Install the differential case assembly in the
differential carrier assembly.
HINT:
• Make sure the right and left races are not
interchanged.
• Make sure that there is a backlash between the
ring rear and drive pinion.
11. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL BEARING
ADJUSTING NUT
(a) Install the rear differential bearing adjusting nuts into
the carrier, making sure the nuts are threaded
properly.
C028221
Matchmarks
C030539E03
12. ADJUST BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Align the matchmarks on the bearing cap and
differential carrier assembly.
(b) Install the 2 bearing caps with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 85 N*m (867 kgf*cm, 63 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
If the bearing cap does not fit tightly on the
differential carrier assembly, the adjusting nuts are
not threaded properly.
DF
DF–68
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
Reinstall the adjusting nuts if necessary.
(c) Tighten the 4 bearing cap bolts to the specified
torque, then loosen them to the point where the
adjusting nuts can be turned by SST.
SST 09504-00011
SST
F051389E01
(d) Using the SST, tighten the adjusting nut on the ring
gear side until the ring has a backlash of about 0.2
mm (0.008 in.).
SST 09504-00011
DF
SST
Z006953E01
(e) While turning the ring gear, use the SST to fully
tighten the adjusting nut on the drive pinion side.
After the bearings have settled, loosen the adjusting
nut on the drive pinion side.
(f) Using SST, torque the adjusting nut 1 to 1.5 notches
from the 0 preload position.
SST
Z006917E03
(g) Using a dial indicator, adjust the ring gear backlash
until it is within the specification.
Backlash:
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
SST 09504-00011
HINT:
The backlash is adjusted by turning the left and right
adjusting nuts for an equal amounts. For example,
loosen the nut on the right side by one notch.
SST
C013842E02
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–69
(h) Torque the bearing cap bolts.
Torque: 85 N*m (867 kgf*cm, 63 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
F052194E01
13. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with
the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.39 to 0.59 N*m (4.0
to 6.0 kgf*cm, 3.5 to 5.2 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
C003092
14. INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVE PINION
(a) Coat 3 or 4 teeth at 3 different positions on the ring
gear with red lead primer.
(b) Hold the companion flange firmly and rotate the ring
gear in both directions.
C014071
DF
DF–70
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
(c) Inspect the tooth contact pattern.
Plate washer
ZK01912E04
Heel Contact
DF
Face Contact
Proper Contact
Select an adjusting washer that bring the drive pinion closer to the ring gear
Toe Contact
Flank Contact
Select an adjusting washer that shift the drive pinion away from the ring gear
SA01653E10
If the teeth are not engaged properly, use the
following chart to select an appropriate washer for
correction.
Plate Washer thickness
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.70 (0.0669)
2.03 (0.0799)
1.73 (0.0681)
2.06 (0.0811)
1.76 (0.0693)
2.09 (0.0823)
1.79 (0.0705)
2.12 (0.0835)
1.82 (0.0717)
2.15 (0.0847)
1.85 (0.0728)
2.18 (0.0853)
1.88 (0.0740)
2.21 (0.0870)
1.91 (0.0752)
2.24 (0.0882)
1.94 (0.0764)
2.27 (0.0894)
1.97 (0.0776)
2.30 (0.0906)
2.00 (0.0787)
2.33 (0.0917)
15. REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
(a) Using SST to hold the drive pinion companion
flange, remove the nut.
SST 09330-00021
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–71
16. REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using SST, remove the drive pinion companion
flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03030)
17. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
18. REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the drive pinion tapered roller
bearing from the drive pinion.
SST 09556-22010
19. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
BEARING SPACER
(a) Install a new bearing spacer onto the drive pinion.
20. INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Install the drive pinion, rear drive pinion taper roller
bearing and rear differential drive oil slinger.
21. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
SST
22. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, install a new carrier oil
seal.
SST 09554-30011
Oil seal drive in depth:
0.55 to 1.45 mm (0.021 to 0.057 in.)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with the MP grease.
F052183E01
23. INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using SST, install the drive pinion companion flange
onto the drive pinion.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03030),
09330-00021
(b) Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil
LSD.
SST
F052182E01
DF
DF–72
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
(c) Using SST to hold the flange, tighten the nut.
Torque: 215 N*m (2,190 kgf*cm, 159 ft.*lbf)
SST 09330-00021
SST
ZK09978E01
24. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting)
DF
SA02352
Bearing
Standard
New
1.05 to 1.64 N*m (10.7 to 16.7 kgf*cm, 9.3 to 14.5 in.*lbf)
Reused
0.56 to 0.85 N*m (5.7 to 8.7 kgf*cm, 5.0 to 7.5 in.*lbf)
If the preload is greater than the specification,
replace the bearing spacer.
If the preload is less than the specification, retighten
the nut to 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft*lbf) of torque at a
time until the specified preload is reached.
Torque: 370 N*m (3,773 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf) or
less
If the maximum torque is exceeded while
retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repeat the preload adjusting procedure. Do not
loosen the pinion nut to reduce the preload.
25. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.39 to 0.59 N*m (4.0
to 6.0 kgf*cm, 3.5 to 5.2 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential.
SA02352
26. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR BACKLASH
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash of the ring
gear.
Backlash:
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust
or repair the side bearing preload as necessary.
C028211
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
30 mm (1.18 in.)
F001237E03
DF–73
27. INSPECT RUNOUT OF REAR DRIVE PINION
COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the
drive pinion companion flange vertically and
horizontally.
Maximum runout:
Vertical runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Lateral runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the runouts are not within the specifications,
replace the companion flange.
28. INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, stake the drive pinion
nut.
(b) 2WD drive type:
Using a "Torx" socket (E10), install the 4 stud bolts.
Torque: 10 N*m (101 kgf*cm, 7.3 ft.*lbf)
ZK07449
29. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL BEARING
ADJUSTING NUT LOCK
(a) Install 2 new rear differential bearing adjusting locks
onto the bearing caps.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(b) After tightening the 2 bolts, bend the nut locks.
C028226
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the contact surfaces of the rear differential
carrier assembly and the rear axle housing
assembly.
(b) Install the new rear differential carrier gasket and
the differential carrier assembly with the 10 nuts and
10 washers.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT WITH BACKING PLATE
(See page AH-27)
3.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-16)
4.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
5.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING
6.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING (See page PB-16)
7.
INSTALL REAR DISC (See page BR-47)
C030284
DF
DF–74
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
8.
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the rear disc brake caliper assembly LH with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
9.
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Install the rear disc brake caliper assembly RH with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
10. CONNECT REAR SPEED SENSOR LH (See page BC213)
DF
11. CONNECT REAR SPEED SENSOR RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by following the same procedures as
the LH side.
12. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
See procedure
Vehicle Type
Proceed to
2WD
PR-6
4WD
PR-12
13. FILL UP RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
14. BLEED MASTER CYLINDER
15. BLEED BRAKE LINE
16. BLEED BRAKE FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
17. CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
18. FILL UP DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
19. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
20. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 in.*lbf)
21. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER
TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
22. INSPECT CHECK ABS SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
DF–4
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
DRIVE LINE
DIFFERENTIAL
COMPONENTS
4WD DRIVE TYPE:
2WD DRIVE TYPE:
COMPANION FLANGE
STUD BOLT
DF
10 (101, 7.3)
215 (2,190, 159)
13 (130, 9)
DUST DEFLECTOR
85 (867, 63)
BEARING SPACER
REAR DRIVE
PINION NUT
OIL SLINGER
215 (2,190, 159)
OIL STORAGE RING
BEARING CAP
13 (130, 9)
FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
FRONT BEARING
REAR DIFFERENTIAL
CARRIER OIL SEAL
ADJUSTING NUT LOCK
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
COMPANION FLANGE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131570E01
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
DF–5
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
2.
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
differential flange.
(b) 2WD Drive Type:
Remove the 4 nuts and 4 washers.
(c) 4WD Drive Type:
Remove the 4 nuts, 4 bolts and 4 washers.
(d) Suspend the propeller shaft assembly with wire or
similar.
3.
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
(a) Using SST and a hammer, unstake the nut.
SST 09930-00010
Matchmarks
C060588E02
SST
C089309E02
(b) Using SST to hold the companion flange, remove
the nut.
SST 09330-00021
SST
C088916E01
4.
SST
F040720E02
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03030)
DF
DF–6
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
5.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-10010
6.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
7.
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the front bearing.
SST 09556-22010
(b) Using SST, remove the front bearing outer race.
SST 09308-00010
(c) Using a screwdriver, bend the oil storage ring and
remove it.
8.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
BEARING SPACER
SST
F040717E02
SST
DF
W001770E03
DF–76
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR (for 4WD)
INSPECTION
1.
DF
12 mm
(0.472 in.)
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals 1 to
2.
Standard resistance:
0.1 to 100 Ω
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals 1 or
2 and body ground.
Standard resistance:
5 MΩ or more
If the resistance value is not as specified, replace
the differential vacuum actuator assembly.
(c) Apply battery positive voltage between the terminal
1 to 2, and check the actuator operation by sound,
actuator status and continuity between the terminal
3 to 4, 5 to 4 and 6 to 4.
F043678E06
Battery voltage applied
terminal
3 to 4 terminals
continuity
5 to 4 terminals
continuity
6 to 4 terminals
continuity
Actuator status
1 (+) - 2 (-)
Continuity
Continuity
No continuity
Connected
1 (-) - 2 (+)
No continuity
No continuity
Continuity
Disconnected
INSTALLATION
1.
G023140
F043679
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the any oil FIPG material and be careful
not to drop oil on the contact surfaces of the
actuator and clutch case.
(b) Clean connecting surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
(c) Apply FIPG to the differential tube, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
HINT:
Install the actuator within 10 minutes after applying
FIPG.
(d) Clean the threads of the 4 bolts and retainer bolt
holes with toluene or trichloroethylene.
(e) Install the differential vacuum actuator assembly to
the differential tube.
(f) Apply adhesive to 2 to 3 threads of the bolts end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
(g) Install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 21 N*m (210 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR (for 4WD)
DF–77
(h) Connect the actuator hose and connector.
(i) Install the No. 1 mounting support with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 186 N*m (1,900 kgf*cm, 137 ft.*lbf)
(j) Install the No. 2 mounting support with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 160 N*m (1,630 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
(k) Install the front differential support No. 3 with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 108 N*m (1,100 kgf*cm, 80 ft.*lbf)
(l) Support the front differential with a jack.
(m) Install the 2 front mounting bolts and nuts.
Torque: 137 N*m (1,400 kgf*cm, 101 ft.*lbf)
(n) Install the front differential mount nuts No. 1.
Torque: 87 N*m (887 kgf*cm, 64 ft.*lbf)
(o) Install the front differential breather tube bracket
with a bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(p) Lower the jack.
C097020
2.
INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-19)
3.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
4.
INSPECT AND ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See
page DF-3)
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1
with the 4 bolts.
6.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Install the engine under cover assembly rear with
the 6 bolts.
DF
DIFFERENTIAL – DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL (for 4WD)
DF–9
DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL (for 4WD)
DRIVE LINE
DIFFERENTIAL
COMPONENTS
DF
DIFFERENTIAL SIDE
GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
CARRIER ASSEMBLY
C139559E01
DF–10
DIFFERENTIAL – DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL (for 4WD)
REMOVAL
DF
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and engine under cover
assembly rear.
3.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 engine under cover
sub-assembly.
4.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
5.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (See page AH14)
6.
SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page
BC-211)
7.
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See
page PS-20)
8.
SEPARATE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page SP-22)
9.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-5)
10. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
SST
C097017E02
INSTALLATION
SST
C097018E01
1.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal.
SST 09554-30011
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-9)
3.
CONNECT NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page SP-26)
4.
CONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See
page PS-34)
5.
CONNECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page
BC-211)
6.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (See page AH17)
DIFFERENTIAL – DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL (for 4WD)
DF–11
7.
FILL UP DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
8.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
9.
INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 engine under cover sub-assembly
with the 4 bolts.
10. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Install the engine under cover assembly with the 6
bolts.
11. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
12. INSPECT ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
DF
DIFFERENTIAL: 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD): COMPO...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Drivetrain
Section: Axle/Differential
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000016GB004X
Title: DIFFERENTIAL: 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD): COMPONENTS (2007
4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
DIFFERENTIAL: 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD): COMPO...
ILLUSTRATION
DIFFERENTIAL: 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD): COMPO...
DIFFERENTIAL: 1GR-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD): COMPO...
ILLUSTRATION
DF–35
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for
4WD)
DRIVE LINE
DIFFERENTIAL
COMPONENTS
13 (133, 10)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL BREATHER HOSE
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL BREATHER TUBE
DF
SNAP RING
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY RH
88 (897, 65)
FRONT PROPELLER
SHAFT ASSEMBLY
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
CARRIER ASSEMBLY
88 (897, 65)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
SUPPORT NO. 3
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
MOUNT
STOPPER UPR
x2
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
MOUNT STOPPER UPR
108 (1,101, 80)
87 (887, 64)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
MOUNT NUT NO. 1
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SUPPORT NO. 2
SNAP RING
160 (1,630, 118)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY LH
137 (1,397, 101)
186 (1,897, 137)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
MOUNT STOPPER LWR
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT NO. 1
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL MOUNT STOPPER LWR
137 (1,397, 101)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131362E04
DF–36
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
REMOVAL
DF
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
2.
REMOVE REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and engine under cover
assembly.
3.
REMOVE NO.1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 engine under cover
sub-assembly.
4.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
5.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-14)
6.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (See page AH14)
7.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
8.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SP-28)
9.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
10. SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page
BC-211)
11. SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
12. SEPARATE TIE ROD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See page
PS-20)
13. SEPARATE TIE ROD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH (See page
PS-20)
14. REMOVE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page SP-22)
15. REMOVE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure as for the LH side.
16. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-5)
17. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH (See
page DS-5)
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
C097020E05
DF–37
18. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the front differential
breather tube bracket.
(b) Support the front differential with a jack.
(c) Remove the front differential mount nut No. 1.
(d) Remove the 2 front mounting bolts and 2 nuts.
(e) Lower the jack and remove the front differential
assembly.
(f) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 3 front differential
support.
(g) Remove the 5 bolts and 2 front differential supports.
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, remove the differential
tube.
C097021
2.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
3.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE PINION COMPANION
FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and a hammer, remove the nut.
SST 09930-00010
SST
R013209E01
SST
F044234E01
DF
DF–38
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(b) Using SST to hold the companion flange, remove
the nut.
SST 09330-00021 (09330-00030)
SST
SA02349E05
(c) Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
DF
SST
F052175E01
4.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal from the differential
carrier assembly.
SST 09308-10010
5.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
6.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the rear bearing from the drive
pinion.
SST 09556-22010
(b) Remove the bearing spacer.
7.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the union.
(b) Remove the 10 bolts and tap out the side bearing
retainer with a plastic hammer.
8.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
SST
SA02348E03
SST
Z000641E04
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–39
10. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the front bearing
and washer from the drive pinion.
SST 09950-00020
HINT:
If the drive gear or ring gear is damaged, replace
them as a set.
SST
R002482E02
11. REMOVE FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the front
bearing outer race.
DF
R013226
12. REMOVE REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
(a) Using SST, remove the rear bearing outer race.
SST 09502-12010, 09612-65014 (09612-01020,
09612-01050)
(b) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the oil
storage ring.
SST
F044257E01
13. REMOVE SIDE BEARING OUTER RACE
HINT:
• Measure the plate washer and note its thickness.
• Tag the bearing outer races to show the location for
reassembly.
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the outer race and
plate washer from the bearing retainer.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00680), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
SST
R013211E01
DF–40
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the outer race and
plate washer from the differential carrier assembly.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00680), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
SST
R013213E01
SST
DF
SST
R011392E02
RA00997
14. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on the ring gear and differential
case assembly.
(b) Remove the 10 bolts.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap on the ring gear to
separate it from the differential case assembly.
15. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the 2 differential case bearings
from the differential case assembly.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00390), 09950-40011
(09951-04020, 09952-04010, 09953-04030,
09954-04010, 09955-04061, 09957-04010,
09958-04011)
HINT:
Fix the claws of SST into the notch in the differential
case assembly.
16. DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove the
straight pin.
(b) Remove these parts from the differential case
assembly.
(1) 2 Differential side gears
(2) 2 Differential side gear thrust washers
(3) Differential pinion shaft
(4) 2 Differential pinion gears
(5) 2 Differential pinion gear thrust washers
17. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL GEAR KIT
(a) Check that there is no damage to the pinion gear
and side gear.
If the pinion gear and/or side gear is damaged,
replace the differential gear kit.
18. INSPECT FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Check that the differential case assembly is not
damaged.
If the differential case assembly is damaged,
replace it.
19. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal from the differential
tube.
SST 09308-00010
SST
R013199E01
DIFFERENTIAL – 2UZ-FE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
DF–41
20. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the side gear shaft from the differential
tube.
C097022
21. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
RH BEARING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Using SST, a brass bar and a press, remove the
bearing.
SST 09950-00020
NOTICE:
Do not damage the bearing.
SST
R013420E02
22. REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
(a) Using SST, a socket wrench and a press, remove
the dust deflector.
SST 09950-00020
SST
R004465E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BACKLASH DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
AND DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Using SST and a dial indicator, measure the ring
gear backlash.
SST 09564-32011
Backlash:
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust
or repair the side bearing preload as necessary.
2.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the
backlash between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Torque: 0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5 to 8 kgf*cm, 4.3 to
6.9 in.*lbf)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the
differential assembly.
SST
R012683E03
FA01158
DF
DF–53
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DRIVE LINE
DIFFERENTIAL
COMPONENTS
4WD DRIVE TYPE:
CLIP
66 (670, 48)
O-RING
49 (500, 36)
FILLER PLUG
GASKET
PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY NO. 2
DF
15 (155, 11)
GASKET
BRAKE LINE
49 (500, 36)
DRAIN PLUG
REAR AXLE SHAFT RH
O-RING
PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY NO. 3
20 (204, 15)
66 (670, 48)
x10
88 (897, 65)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER GASKET
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
REAR AXLE SHAFT LH
2WD DRIVE TYPE:
88 (897, 65)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL
CARRIER ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131363E02
DF–54
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
4WD DRIVE TYPE:
PINION GEAR
SIDE GEAR
DF
THRUST WASHER
ADJUSTING NUT
SPIDER
DIFFERENTIAL
RING GEAR
THRUST WASHER
THRUST WASHER
DIFFERENTIAL
RH CASE
REAR DIFFERENTIAL
CASE BEARING
DIFFERENTIAL LH CASE
47 (480, 35)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL
CASE BEARING
x8
DIFFERENTIAL
DRIVE PINION
PLATE WASHER
ADJUSTING NUT
LOCK PLATE
x5
x10
REAR BEARING
97 (985, 71)
REAR BEARING OUTER RACE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131364E02
DIFFERENTIAL – REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY
DF–55
4WD DRIVE TYPE:
2WD DRIVE TYPE:
REAR DRIVE PINION
COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
STUD BOLT
DF
10 (101, 7.3)
215 (2,190, 159)
13 (130, 9)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
85 (867, 63)
BEARING SPACER
OIL SLINGER
215 (2,190, 159)
OIL STORAGE RING
BEARING CAP
13 (130, 9)
FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE
FRONT BEARING
OIL SEAL
ADJUSTING NUT LOCK
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131570E02
DF–74
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR (for 4WD)
1GR-FE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR (for 4WD)
DRIVE LINE
DIFFERENTIAL
COMPONENTS
DF
CONNECTOR
DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
C131365E01
DIFFERENTIAL – 1GR-FE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR (for 4WD)
DF–75
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and engine under cover
assembly rear.
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 engine under cover
sub-assembly.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
4.
DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL (See page DF-3)
5.
REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page PR-14)
6.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL VACUUM ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the front differential
breather tube bracket.
(b) Support the front differential with a jack.
(c) Remove the No. 1 front differential mount nut.
(d) Remove the 2 front mounting bolts and 2 nuts.
(e) Disconnect the actuator hose and connector.
(f) Lower the jack.
C097020
(g) Remove the 4 bolts and differential vacuum actuator
assembly.
F043679
DF
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
AH–9
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB SPACER
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install the new
front axle hub spacer.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the spacer.
2.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE WITH ABS ROTOR BEARING
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing to the
front axle hub.
SST 09649-17010
F042762
SST
AH
C098702E01
3.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB
(a) Apply the MP grease to a new O-ring.
(b) Install the new O-ring to the axle hub.
(c) Install the dust cover, axle hub to the steering
knuckle with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL ADJUSTING NUT
(a) Using SST, install a new adjusting nut.
Torque: 275 N*m (2,804 kgf*cm, 203 ft.*lbf)
SST 09318-12010
5.
INSTALL KNUCKLE GREASE RETAINER CAP INNER
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install a new
knuckle grease retainer cap inner.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the knuckle grease retainer cap
inner.
F042759
SST
F042758E01
F042765
AH–10
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front suspension upper arm assembly
with a new nut.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Install the No. 1 front suspension arm sub-assembly
lower with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 160 N*m (1,630 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the tie rod end sub-assembly with a nut.
Torque: 91 N*m (928 kgf*cm, 67 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
5.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the stabilizer link with a nut to the steering
knuckle.
Torque: 70 N*m (714 kgf*cm, 52 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
6.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
F043605
AH
F042737
F043604
C099158
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
7.
AH–11
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front disc brake caliper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 123 N*m (1,254 kgf*cm, 91 ft.*lbf)
F043121
(b) Install the brake tube bracket to the steering knuckle
with a bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
(c) Using SST, connect the brake tube to the disc brake
caliper assembly.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
F042731
8.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Install the speed sensor wire harness to the steering
knuckle with a bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 clips.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench, install the speed sensor
with the bolt.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
9.
BLEED BRAKE LINE
10. INSPECT FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
11. INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
12. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
13. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
HINT:
(See page SP-4)
F042730
14. INSPECT ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
AH
AH–16
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB SPACER
(a) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install a new front
axle hub spacer.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the spacer.
2.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE WITH ABS ROTOR BEARING
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new bearing to the
front axle hub.
SST 09649-17010
3.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB
(a) Apply MP grease to a new O-ring.
(b) Install the new O-ring to the axle hub.
(c) Install the dust cover and axle hub to the steering
knuckle with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL STEERING KNUCKLE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new steering
knuckle oil seal.
SST 09527-17011, 09950-70010 (09951-07100),
09951-01000
F042762
SST
AH
C098702E01
F042759
SST
F042767E02
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
AH–17
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front suspension upper arm assembly
with a nut.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Install the No. 1 front suspension arm sub-assembly
lower with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 160 N*m (1,630 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
F043605
F042737
4.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the tie rod end sub-assembly with the nut.
Torque: 91 N*m (928 kgf*cm, 67 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
5.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the stabilizer link with a nut to the steering
knuckle.
Torque: 70 N*m (714 kgf*cm, 52 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
F043604
C099158
AH
AH–18
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
6.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT
(a) Install the hub nut.
Torque: 235 N*m (2,396 kgf*cm, 173 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the adjusting cap and cotter pin.
7.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB GREASE CAP
8.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
9.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front disc brake caliper assembly with the
2 bolts.
Torque: 123 N*m (1,254 kgf*cm, 91 ft.*lbf)
F042732
AH
F043121
(b) Install the brake tube bracket to the steering knuckle
with a bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
(c) Using SST, connect the brake tube to the disc brake
caliper assembly.
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
F042731
10. INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Install the speed sensor wire harness to the steering
knuckle with a bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 clips.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench, install the speed sensor
with the bolt.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
11. BLEED BRAKE LINE
12. INSPECT FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
13. CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
14. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
15. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
HINT:
(See page SP-4)
F042730
16. INSPECT ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
AH–24
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
REMOVAL
AH
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR SPEED SENSOR (See page BC-213)
3.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY (See page BR-45)
4.
REMOVE REAR DISC
5.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN
TENSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
6.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
7.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
8.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-14)
9.
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT WITH BACKING
PLATE
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and rear axle shaft with backing
plate.
(b) Remove the O-ring.
F042741
10. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the rear axle shaft oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
SST
F042742E01
11. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
F042773
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
AH–25
12. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT
(a) Using SST and press, remove the rear axle shaft.
SST 09521-25011, 09521-25023
SST
SST
F042774E01
AH
AH–1
AXLE – AXLE SYSTEM
AXLE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem.
The numbers indicate the ranked order of probability of each
of the possible causes. Check each part in order. If
necessary, replace these parts.
AXLE SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
Wander/pulls
Front wheel shimmy
Rear wheel shimmy
See page
1. Hub bearings (Loosen or worn)
AH-1
1. Ball joints (Worn)
SP-24
2. Hub bearings (Loosen or worn)
AH-1
3. Steering linkage (Loosen or worn)
-
4. Steering gear (Out of adjustment or broken)
-
1. Hub bearings (Loosen or worn)
AH-1
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
F042745
INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the front wheel.
(b) Remove front disc brake caliper (See page BR-39).
(c) Remove the front disc.
(d) Inspect the axle hub backlash.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash near
the center of the axle hub.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace
the bearing.
(e) Inspect the axle hub deviation.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the distortion at
the surface of the axle hub.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the deviation exceeds the maximum, replace
the bearing.
F042746
2.
F042747
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the rear wheel.
(b) Remove the rear disc brake caliper (See page BR45).
(c) Remove the rear disc.
(d) Inspect the axle shaft backlash.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash near
the center of the axle shaft.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace
the bearing.
AH
AH–2
AXLE – AXLE SYSTEM
(e) Inspect the axle shaft deviation.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the distortion at
the surface of the axle shaft.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the deviation exceeds the maximum, replace
the bearing.
F042748
AH
AH–26
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE REAR AXLE BEARING RETAINER INNER
(a) Remove the rear axle bearing retainer inner from
the rear axle bearing assembly.
2.
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT WASHER
(a) Remove the rear axle shaft washer from the rear
axle bearing assembly.
3.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE PLATE TO REAR AXLE
HOUSING BOLT
(a) Attach the 4 nuts to the parking brake plate to rear
axle housing bolts.
(b) Using a hammer, remove the 4 parking brake plate
to rear axle housing bolts and rear axle bearing
assembly.
NOTICE:
Do not reuse the nuts previously removed from
the vehicle.
4.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
(a) Using SST, remove the 6 hub bolts.
SST 09650-17011
6.
REMOVE BRAKE DRUM OIL DEFLECTOR
7.
REMOVE BRAKE DRUM OIL DEFLECTOR GASKET
8.
REMOVE REAR AXLE BEARING OIL SEAL
(a) Grind the rear axle bearing inner race surface using
a grinder, then chisel them out with a chisel.
(b) Remove the rear axle shaft oil seal from the rear
axle shaft.
9.
INSPECT REAR AXLE SHAFT (See page AH-26)
AH
F042776
SST
F042775E01
F042797
INSPECTION
1.
R012254
INSPECT REAR AXLE SHAFT
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the
shaft and flange.
Maximum runout:
Shaft runout: 1.5 mm (0.0591 in.)
Flange runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the rear axle shaft or flange is damaged or worn,
or the runout is greater than the maximum, replace
the rear axle shaft.
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
AH–27
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
(a) Install a new deflector gasket and deflector to the
rear axle shaft.
HINT:
Align the 2 notches.
G020977
(b) Pass the 6 bolts through the axle hub.
(c) Pass a washer plate, as shown in the illustration,
through the hub bolt, and install the hub bolt as
tightening the hub nut.
2.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY
G020973
3.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE PLATE TO REAR AXLE
HOUSING BOLT
(a) Position the backing plate on a rear axle bearing
assembly, and install the 4 parking brake plate to
rear axle housing bolts using 2 socket wrenches
and a press.
4.
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT WASHER
(a) Install the rear axle shaft plate washer onto the rear
axle shaft.
5.
INSTALL REAR AXLE BEARING RETAINER INNER
(a) Install a new rear axle bearing retainer inner to the
rear axle shaft.
F042777
INSTALLATION
1.
SST
F042778E01
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT
(a) Using SST and a press, install the rear axle shaft to
the rear axle bearing assembly.
SST 09521-25011
AH
AH–28
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
2.
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT SNAP RING
(a) Using a snap ring expander, install a new rear axle
shaft snap ring.
3.
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, install a new axle shaft
oil seal.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00770), 09950-70010
(09951-07150)
4.
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT WITH BACKING PLATE
(a) Install a new O-ring.
(b) Install the rear axle shaft with backing plate with the
4 nuts.
Torque: 123 N*m (1,254 kgf*cm, 91 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-16)
6.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
7.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING
8.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING (See page PB-16)
9.
INSTALL REAR DISC
F042773
SST
AH
F042743E01
F042741
10. CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(See page BR-49)
11. INSTALL REAR SPEED SENSOR (See page BC-213)
12. ADD RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
13. BLEED MASTER CYLINDER
14. BLEED BRAKE LINE
15. INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
16. INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
17. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
18. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER
TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
AH–29
19. INSPECT ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
AH
AH–3
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
123 (1,254, 91)
26 (296, 21)
13 (133, 10)
15 (155, 11)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY LH
BRAKE TUBE
CLIP
110 (1,122, 81)
70 (714, 52)
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
TIE ROD END
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
91 (928, 67)
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DISC
COTTER PIN
160 (1,630, 118)
FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
4WD DRIVE TYPE:
LOCK CAP
FRONT AXLE
HUB GREASE
CAP LH
235 (2,396, 173)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
COTTER PIN
Non-reusable part
C131369E04
AH
AH–4
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, disconnect the brake tube from the disc
brake caliper assembly.
SST 09023-00101
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and disc brake caliper
assembly.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DISC
4.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
(a) Using SST and a screwdriver, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09611-12010
F043121
AH
SST
F044194E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
(a) Install a new hub bolt through the axle hub.
(b) Install the washer plate, as shown in the illustration,
through the hub bolt, and install the hub bolt by
tightening the hub nut.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
3.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the disc brake caliper assembly with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 123 N*m (1,254 kgf*cm, 91 ft.*lbf)
(b) Using SST, connect the brake tube to the disc brake
caliper assembly.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
4.
BLEED BRAKE LINE
5.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
6.
CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
7.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
C098706
F043121
AH–5
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
KNUCKLE GREASE
RETAINER CAP INNER
AH
STEERING KNUCKLE LH
FRONT AXLE WITH ABS
ROTOR BEARING ASSEMBLY
O-RING
80 (816, 59)
DUST COVER
275 (2,804, 203)
FRONT WHEEL
ADJUSTING NUT LH
FRONT AXLE HUB SPACER
FRONT AXLE HUB ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Mp Grease
C139954E01
AH–6
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Using a hexagon wrench, separate the front speed
sensor.
(b) Disconnect the 2 clamps.
(c) Remove the bolt and separate the speed sensor
wire harness from the steering knuckle.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the brake tube
bracket from the steering knuckle.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the brake tube from the front
disc brake caliper assembly.
SST 09023-00101
AH
F042730
F042731
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and front disc brake caliper
assembly.
4.
F043121
REMOVE FRONT DISC
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
AH–7
5.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and separate the stabilizer link
assembly from the steering knuckle.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
6.
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
C099158
(b) Using SST, separate the tie rod end sub-assembly
from the steering knuckle.
SST 09628-62011
AH
SST
F042735E02
7.
SEPARATE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the front lower ball
joint attachment from the front axle.
8.
SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the clip and nut.
(b) Using SST, separate the steering knuckle from the
front suspension upper arm assembly.
SST 09628-62011
9.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) 4WD Drive Type:
Using a plastic hammer, separate the front axle hub
from the front drive shaft.
(b) Remove the front axle hub sub-assembly.
F042737
SST
F042736E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
F042756
REMOVE KNUCKLE GREASE RETAINER CAP INNER
(a) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, remove the
knuckle grease retainer cap inner.
AH–8
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 2WD)
2.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL ADJUSTING NUT
(a) Using SST and a hammer, unstake the adjusting
nut.
SST 09930-00010
F042757
(b) Using SST, remove the adjusting nut.
SST 09318-12010
SST
AH
F042758E01
3.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and axle hub from the steering
knuckle.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the axle hub.
4.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE WITH ABS ROTOR LH
BEARING ASSEMBLY
(a) Fix the front axle hub soft in vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09710-30021 (09710-03051), 09950-40011
(09951-04020, 09952-04010, 09953-04020,
09954-04010, 09955-04061, 09957-04010,
09958-04011)
5.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB SPACER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the front axle hub
spacer.
F042759
SST
F042760E02
F042761
AH–12
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
123 (1,254, 91)
26 (296, 21)
13 (133, 10)
AH
15 (155, 11)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY LH
BRAKE TUBE
CLIP
110 (1,122, 81)
70 (714, 52)
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
TIE ROD END
SUB-ASSEMBLY
91 (928, 67)
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY
FRONT DISC
COTTER PIN
160 (1,630, 118)
FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
LOCK CAP
FRONT AXLE
HUB GREASE
CAP
235 (2,396, 173)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
COTTER PIN
Non-reusable part
C139736E01
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
AH–13
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Using a hexagon wrench, separate the speed
sensor front.
(b) Disengage the 2 clamps.
(c) Remove the bolt and separate the speed sensor
wire harness from the steering knuckle.
AH
F042730
3.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the brake tube
bracket from the steering knuckle.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the brake tube from the disc
brake cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
F042731
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and front disc brake caliper
assembly.
4.
F043121
REMOVE FRONT DISC
AH–14
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
5.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB GREASE CAP
(a) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, remove the
front axle hub grease cap.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the axle hub.
6.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and a lock cap.
(b) Remove the front axle hub nut.
7.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and separate the stabilizer link
assembly from the steering knuckle.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
8.
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(b) Using SST, separate the tie rod end sub-assembly
from the steering knuckle.
SST 09628-62011
9.
REMOVE NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the No.1 front
suspension arm sub-assembly lower from the front
steering knuckle.
F042729
AH
F042732
C099158
SST
F042735E01
F042737
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB (for 4WD)
AH–15
10. SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(b) Using SST, separate the steering knuckle from the
front suspension upper arm assembly LH.
SST 09628-62011
SST
F042736E01
11. REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB ASSEMBLY
(a) for 4WD:
(1) Using a plastic hammer, separate the front axle
hub from the front drive shaft.
(b) Remove the front axle hub assembly.
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE STEERING KNUCKLE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the
steering knuckle LH oil seal.
AH
F042766
2.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and axle hub from the steering
knuckle.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the axle hub.
3.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE WITH ABS ROTOR BEARING
ASSEMBLY
(a) Fix the front axle hub soft in vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09710-30021 (09710-03051), 09950-40011
(09951-04020, 09952-04010, 09953-04020,
09954-04010, 09955-04061, 09957-04010,
09958-04011)
4.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB SPACER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the front axle hub
spacer.
F042759
SST
F042760E02
F042761
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
AH–19
REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
15 (155, 11)
BRAKE TUBE
REAR AXLE
HUB BOLT
47 (480, 35)
REAR DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
AH
123 (1,254, 91)
REAR AXLE SHAFT
WITH BACKING PLATE
O-RING
REAR AXLE
SHAFT OIL SEAL
8.3 (85, 73 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 3
PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
REAR DISC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131371E03
AH–20
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
REMOVAL
AH
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR SPEED SENSOR (See page BC-213)
3.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY (See page BR-45)
4.
REMOVE REAR DISC
5.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN
TENSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
6.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
7.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
8.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-14)
9.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
(a) Using SST, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09650-17011
SST
G020975E01
INSTALLATION
G020976
1.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
(a) Pass a new hub bolt through the axle hub.
(b) Pass a washer plate, as shown in the illustration,
through the hub bolt, and install the hub bolt as
tightening the hub nut.
2.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-16)
3.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
4.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING
5.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING (See page PB-16)
6.
INSTALL REAR DISC
7.
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
(See page BR-49)
8.
INSTALL REAR SPEED SENSOR (See page BC-213)
9.
ADJUST RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
10. BLEED BRAKE LINE
11. INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
12. INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
13. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,142 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
AH–21
14. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER
TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
15. INSPECT ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
AH
AH–22
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
REAR AXLE SHAFT
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
15 (155, 11)
BRAKE TUBE
REAR AXLE
HUB BOLT
47 (480, 35)
REAR DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY
AH
123 (1,254, 91)
REAR AXLE SHAFT
WITH BACKING PLATE
O-RING
REAR AXLE
SHAFT OIL SEAL
8.3 (85, 73 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 3
PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
REAR DISC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131371E04
AH–23
AXLE – REAR AXLE SHAFT
REAR AXLE SHAFT SNAP RING
REAR AXLE SHAFT WASHER
REAR AXLE BEARING ASSEMBLY
PARKING BRAKE PLATE TO
REAR AXLE HOUSING BOLT
REAR AXLE BEARING
RETAINER INNER
AH
BACKING PLATE
x6
REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
BRAKE DRUM OIL DEFLECTOR
BRAKE DRUM OIL DEFLECTOR GASKET
REAR AXLE SHAFT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131372E02
SC–4
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
ADJUSTMENT
SC
HIGH
NORMAL
LOW
1.
ADJUST STANDARD VEHICLE HEIGHT
(a) Release the parking brake and stabilize the
suspensions by pushing up and down on the
corners of the vehicle.
(b) Place the shift lever into the "N" position and settle
the tires by moving the vehicle back and forth.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) On the height control switch, first press "HIGH" to
raise the vehicle height, and then change the switch
to "LOW" to lower it. Perform this operation one
more time.
NOTICE:
Make sure to release the parking brake and
move the shift lever into the "N" position.
2.
INSPECT TIRE
(See page TW-1)
3.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
(See page SP-4)
4.
OPERATE HEIGHT CONTROL SWITCH AND CHECK
VEHICLE HEIGHT CHANGE
(a) Start the engine and change the height control
switch from the NORMAL position to the HIGH and
LOW positions.
Check the time until the height adjustment is
completed and the amount of change in vehicle
height.
Adjustment time:
From operation of height control switch to start of
compressor.
Approx. 2 sec.
From start of compressor to completion of height
adjustment.
15 to 20 sec.
(HIGH position)
Amount of change in vehicle height:
HIGH position:
40 mm (1.57 in.)
LOW position:
-20 mm (-0.79 in.)
C099140E01
SC–5
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) While adjusting vehicle height in the HIGH position,
start the engine and change the height control
switch from the HIGH and LOW position to the
NORMAL position.
Check the time until the height adjustment is
completed and the amount of change in vehicle
height.
Adjustment time:
HIGH
NORMAL
LOW
From operation of height control switch to open of
exhaust valve.
Approx. 2 sec.
From open of exhaust valve to completion of height
adjustment.
10 to 15 sec.
(HIGH position)
Amount of change in vehicle height:
HIGH position:
40 mm (1.57 in.)
LOW position:
-20 (-0.79 mm)
5.
C099139E01
CHECK CONNECTIONS OF TUBES FOR AIR
LEAKAGE
(a) Set the height control switch in the HIGH position
and raise the vehicle height.
(b) Stop the engine.
SC
SC–6
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Apply soapy water to the connections of the tubes
and check if there is any air leakage.
Front
SC
C099141E01
6.
D
C
C125412E01
ADJUST VEHICLE HEIGHT
NOTICE:
While adjusting vehicle height, do not put anyone or
anything on or in the vehicle as it will affect vehicle
height.
(a) Suspend the vehicle height control by pressing the
height control mode select switch.
(b) Put the vehicle on a level surface.
(c) Measure the vehicle height (C - D measurement) on
the right side and left side.
Standard vehicle height value:
See page SP-4
Difference between the right side and left side:
10 mm (0.39 in.) or less
(d) If the actual vehicle height differs from the vehicle
height (C - D measurement), adjust it by jacking up
the frame, etc. (Procedure "A").
(e) Using the intelligent tester (Procedure "B").
(1) Turn the ignition switch to ON or ACC.
SC–7
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
(2) Using the intelligent tester, measure each
vehicle height value of the right side and the left
side sensors.
Difference between the tester value and
vehicle height (C - D measurement):
5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
Difference between the right side and the
left side:
5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
(f)
Low
Normal
High
LH:
(+)
(+)
(-)
(-)
RH: (+)
Not using the intelligent tester (Procedure "C").
(1) Disconnect the connector of the height control
sensor.
(2) Connect three 1.5 V dry cell batteries in series.
(3) Connect the battery positive (+) and negative () to the terminals as shown in the illustration.
Standard voltage
Position
Voltage
High
2.58 to 2.98 V
Normal
2.11 to 2.51 V
Low
1.76 to 2.16 V
Difference between the right side and the
left side:
0.2 V or less
(+)
(-)
(-)
F043224E01
C125314
Lock Nut
C125303E01
(g) If the procedure "B" or "C" differs from the vehicle
height (C - D measurement), adjust it by following
the procedures below:
(1) Loosen the nut.
(2) Move the height control sensor link up and
down along the slotted hole of the bracket.
(3) Adjust the vehicle height to the vehicle height
(C - D measurement) while checking the value
on the intelligent tester or voltmeter.
(4) Tighten the nut.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(h) If the vehicle height cannot be adjusted by
performing procedure "A" , adjust it again by
following the procedures below:
(1) Loosen the 2 lock nuts of the height control
sensor link.
(2) Adjust the vehicle height to the vehicle height
(C - D measurement) by turning the link while
checking the value on the intelligent tester or
the voltmeter.
(3) Tighten the 2 lock nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
SC
SC–8
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
(i)
A
A
C125304E01
SC
Check that the lengths of the screw parts, "A" in the
illustration, are within the standard values.
Standard length:
6.5 to 15.0 mm (0.26 to 0.59 in.)
(j) Change the vehicle height. (From the normal
position to the high position, and from the high
position to the normal position)
(k) Measure the vehicle height (C - D measurement) on
the right side and left side (Procedure "D").
(l) Check if the vehicle height (C - D measurement) is
within the specified range.
HINT:
If the values are outside the standard, perform the
procedures from procedure "A" to "D" again.
SC–12
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Step 3, 6, 9, 12:
Diagnostic steps permitting use of the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
SC
3
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check for a DTC (See page SC-23).
NEXT
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Symptom Does Not Occur (Go to step 5)
Symptom Occurs (Go to step 6)
NEXT
5
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
6
CHECK DTC
(a) Check for a DTC (See page SC-23).
Normal System Code OUTPUT (Go to step 7)
DTC OUTPUT (Go to step 8)
7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Refer to the Problem Symptoms Table (See page SC18).
NEXT
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
8
SC–13
DTC CHART
(a) Refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart (See page
SC-26).
NEXT
9
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
(a) Inspect the circuit (See page SC-30 to SC-74).
NEXT
10
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
SC
NEXT
11
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
12
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
SC–14
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
TEST MODE PROCEDURE
1.
SC
(3) Using SST, connect terminals TS and CG of the
DLC3.
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
CG
DLC3:
INPUT SIGNAL CHECK (Using SST check wire)
HINT:
• This function checks if signals from the stop light
switch assembly and the door courtesy light switch,
etc. are being input normally to the ECU.
• When entering test mode, the suspension control
ECU sets all the test mode DTCs first.
After completing the test mode for each check item,
the test mode DTCs that are determined normal by
the suspension control ECU will be erased.
The test mode DTCs for other check items may not be
erased when only a certain signal is inspected.
• When the test mode returns back to normal mode, all
the test mode DTCs will be erased.
(a) Procedure for Input Signal Check Mode (Test Mode)
using SST check wire.
SST 09843-18040
(1) Make sure the ignition switch is OFF.
(2) Set each of the check items to the condition
shown as Operation (A) in the test mode table.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
F100115E29
F041675
(5) Check that the height control OFF indicator light
is blinking.
HINT:
• The height control OFF indicator light comes
on for 2 seconds, then blinks at 0.25 sec.
intervals.
• If the height control OFF indicator light does
not blink, inspect the height control manual
indicator light circuit (See page SC-74) and
the TS terminal circuit (See page SC-80).
(6) Set each of the check items to the condition
shown as Operation (B) in the test mode table.
HINT:
When checking each item, the height control
OFF indicator light should comes on for 1
second.
Test mode table
Check Item
Operation (A)
Operation (B)
Stop light switch signal
OFF (Brake pedal not depressed)
ON (Brake pedal depressed)
Door courtesy light switch signal
ON (Each door opened)
OFF (All doors closed)
SC–15
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Check Item
Operation (A)
Height control switch signal
Operation (B)
Press the height control switch "UP" first
and then press "DOWN"
-
Height control OFF switch signal
OFF (Height control OFF switch not
pushed in)
ON to OFF (Height control OFF switch
pushed in and released)
Right front speed sensor signal
Vehicle speed below 20 km/h (12 mph)
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or higher
Left front speed sensor signal
Vehicle speed below 20 km/h (12 mph)
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or higher
Crankshaft position sensor signal
Engine speed below 2,000 rpm
Engine speed 2,000 rpm or higher
(7) Using SST, connect the 3rd terminal of the SST
check wire to terminal TC of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
CG
DLC3:
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
TC
SC
F100115E28
(8) Read the number of blinks of the height control
OFF indicator light.
HINT:
• As examples, the blinking patterns of a
normal system code and code 82 are shown
in the illustration.
• If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the
same time, the lowest numbered code is
displayed first.
• When a DTC is not output, check the TC
terminal circuit (See page SC-78).
(9) Check the malfunction using the test mode DTC
chart.
F041675
Code 82:
Normal:
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4.5 sec.
Repeat
C120690E01
(b) Ending the Input Signal Check Mode (Test Mode)
using SST check wire.
SST 09843-18040
(1) With the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the SST
check wire from the terminals of the DLC3 and
then turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Procedure for Sensor Test Mode (Test Mode) using
the intelligent tester.
(1) Make sure the ignition switch is OFF.
(2) Set each of the check items to the condition
shown as Operation (A) in the test mode table.
SC–16
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(3) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(5) Select SIGNAL CHECK mode on the intelligent
tester.
(6) Set each of the check items to the condition
shown as Operation (B) in the test mode table
(Procedure "A").
HINT:
In procedure "A", all signals can be checked
together.
(7) Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operators manual
for further details.
(d) DTC of air suspension system test mode (input
signal check) function:
If a trouble code is displayed during the test mode
DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code. For
details of each code, refer to "See page" under the
respective DTC No. in the chart.
SC
Test Mode DTC Chart
DTC No.
C1782/82
Detection Item
Stop light switch circuit malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Stop light switch assembly
Stop light switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
•
•
•
Door courtesy light switch assembly
Back door lock assembly (Back door
courtesy light switch)
Door courtesy light switch circuit
Body ECU
Back door ECU
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Height control switch
Height control switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Height control OFF switch (Suspension
control switch)
Height control OFF switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
C1783/83
Door courtesy switch circuit malfunction
C1786/86
Height control switch circuit malfunction
C1788/88
Height control OFF switch circuit malfunction
C1794/94
Right front speed sensor circuit malfunction
•
•
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU assembly
Suspension control ECU
C1795/95
Left front speed sensor circuit malfunction
•
•
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU assembly
Suspension control ECU
C1797/97
Crankshaft position sensor circuit malfunction
•
•
•
•
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ECM
Suspension control ECU
2.
INPUT SIGNAL CHECK (Using INTELLIGENT
TESTER)
HINT:
• This function checks if signals from the stop light
switch assembly and the door courtesy light switch,
etc. are being input normally to the ECU.
SC–17
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
• When entering test mode, the suspension control
ECU sets all the test mode DTCs first.
After completing the test mode for each check item,
the test mode DTCs that are determined normal by
the suspension control ECU will be erased.
The test mode DTCs for other check items may not be
erased when only a certain signal is inspected.
• When the test mode returns back to normal mode, all
the test mode DTCs will be erased.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
A066288E03
(a) Procedure for Test Mode (Input signal check).
(1) Make sure that the ignition switch is off.
(2) Set each of the check items to the condition
shown as Operation (A) in the test mode table.
(3) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(5) Select TEST MODE mode on the intelligent
tester.
(6) Set each of the check items to the condition
shown as Operation (B) in the test mode table
(Procedure "C").
Test mode (input signal check) table
Check Item
Operation (A)
Stop light switch signal
OFF (Brake pedal not depressed)
Door courtesy light switch signal
ON (Each door opened)
Height control switch signal
Operation (B)
ON (Brake pedal depressed)
OFF (All doors closed)
Press the height control switch "UP" first
and then press "DOWN"
-
Height control OFF switch signal
OFF (Height control OFF switch not
pushed in)
ON to OFF (Height control OFF switch
pushed in and released)
Right front speed sensor signal
Vehicle speed below 20 km/h (12 mph)
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or higher
Left front speed sensor signal
Vehicle speed below 20 km/h (12 mph)
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or higher
Crankshaft position sensor signal
Engine speed below 2,000 rpm
Engine speed 2,000 rpm or higher
HINT:
In procedure "C", all signals can be checked
together.
(7) Read the test mode DTCs by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
(8) Check the malfunction using the code table
below. After completing the test mode,
disconnect the tester and turn the ignition switch
off.
SC
SC–18
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(b) DTC of air suspension system test mode (input
signal check) function:
If a trouble code is displayed during the test mode
DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code. For
details of each code, refer to "See page" under the
respective DTC No. in the chart.
Test Mode DTC Chart
DTC No.
C1782/82
Detection Item
Stop light switch assembly
Stop light switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
•
•
•
Door courtesy light switch assembly
Back door lock assembly (Back door
courtesy light switch)
Door courtesy light switch circuit
Main Body ECU
Back door ECU
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Height control switch
Height control switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Height control OFF switch (Suspension
control switch)
Height control OFF switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
Right front speed sensor circuit malfunction
•
•
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU assembly
Suspension control ECU
Left front speed sensor circuit malfunction
•
•
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU assembly
Suspension control ECU
Crankshaft position sensor circuit malfunction
•
•
•
•
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ECM
Suspension control ECU
Stop light switch circuit malfunction
C1783/83
Door courtesy switch circuit malfunction
C1786/86
Height control switch circuit malfunction
SC
C1788/88
C1794/94
C1795/95
C1797/97
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Height control OFF switch circuit malfunction
SC–52
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1751/51
Continuous Electric Current to Height Control
Compressor
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
C1751/51*1
DTC Detecting Condition
With the AIR SUS relay activated, the
vehicle does not go up to the standard
vehicle height after 90 sec. have elapsed.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Height control compressor assembly
Height control compressor circuit
Height control sensor circuit
Height control sensor link sub-assembly
Relief valve
AIR SUS relay circuit
Air leakage from the air tube or each valve
Clogging in the air tube or each valve
Suspension control ECU
*1:
SC
The relief pressure of the compressed air is 980 kPa (10 kgf/cm2, 142 psi).
If the vehicle height control is attempted on a steeply sloping road, when the vehicle is overloaded, or
when the vehicle is jacked up with the engine running, the compressor motor operates continuously to
raise vehicle height, and causes electric current to flow to the AIR SUS relay for 100 seconds or longer.
Thus DTC C1751/51 may be output and vehicle height control may be suspended. (This is not electrically
abnormal.) In this case, however, the vehicle height operation is resumed approx. 10 min. after the
ignition switch is turned ON after the ECU detects the first error. If ECU detects another error, it takes 70
minutes until control is resumed.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT
(a) Inspect the height control compressor circuit (See page
SC-44).
NEXT
2
INSPECT AIR LEAKAGE
(a) Check tube connections for air leakage (See page SC28).
OK:
No leaks
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR TUBE
OK
3
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL VALVE (GATE SOLENOID, LEVELING SOLENOID, EXHAUST
SOLENOID VALVE)
(a) When using intelligent tester:
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON, and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
SC–53
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(3) Select the item "LEVEL SOL REAR", "GATE SOL
REAR", "LOW PRS TNK SOL", "EXHAUST SOL" in
the ACTIVE TEST, and operate it with the intelligent
tester.
(4) Check whether the solenoid makes a sound.
(5) Check whether the height control solenoid valve has
continuity (will vibrate).
OK:
The solenoid makes a sound, and the height
control solenoid valve has continuity. (It will
vibrate.)
(b) When not using intelligent tester:
(1) Disconnect the valve connectors.
(2) Check the operating sound of the valves when
battery positive voltage is applied to the terminals as
shown below.
Gate Solenoid Valve:
Leveling Solenoid Valve:
(+)
3
Solenoid valve
1
2
(-)
Exhaust Solenoid Valve:
2
1
2
Leveling solenoid valve
3
2
Exhaust solenoid valve
1
2
Tank solenoid valve
2
1
OK:
It makes an operating sound (click).
HINT:
• When a malfunction is found in the gate solenoid
valve, the leveling valve or the tank solenoid
valve, replace the height control reservoir
assembly.
• When a malfunction is found in the exhaust
solenoid valve, replace the height control
compressor assembly.
(+)
Tank Solenoid Valve:
2
1
(+)
Battery negative
Gate solenoid valve
1
(-)
Battery positive
(-)
F044510E01
B
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL
COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
A
4
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR LINK SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect and adjust the height control sensor link subassembly.
NEXT
5
CONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC and repeat the procedure to re-check it
(See page SC-23).
SC
SC–54
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
HINT:
If the DTC C1751/51 is still output, proceed to the next
step.
NEXT
REPAIR OR REPLACE PARTS AND COMPONENTS INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTCS
SC
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
SC–55
C1761/61 ECU Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
C1761/61
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Suspension control ECU malfunction
Suspension control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTC C1774/74 (power source circuit) is displayed, perform the inspection necessary for DTC C1774/
74 first (See page SC-54).
• If DTC C1713/13 (right rear height control sensor circuit), C1714/14 (left rear height control sensor
circuit) and C1761/61 (ECU malfunction) are output at the same time, perform the inspection
necessary for DTC C1761/61 first.
1
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and check the height
control OFF indicator light.
Result:
A:
Height control OFF indicator light come on
B:
Height control OFF indicator light does not come
on
B
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
A
2
INSPECT SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU (HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR POWER SOURCE)
S15
GND (-)
S13
SBL2 (+)
SBR2 (+)
F043242E01
OK
(a) Remove the suspension control ECU with connectors
being connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and measure voltage
between terminals S13-20 (SBR2) and S15-1 (GND) and
between terminals S13-22 (SBL2) and S15-1 (GND) of
the suspension control ECU connector.
Standard voltage:
4.5 to 5.5 V
NG
CHECK HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY CIRCUIT
SC
SC–56
3
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECT SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU (ECU POWER SOURCE)
S15
GND (-)
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF, and measure voltage
between terminals S14-6 (B) and S15-1 (GND) and
between S14-6 (B) and S14-5 (GND2) of the suspension
control ECU connector.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
S14
B (+)
NG
GND2 (-)
F043242E02
OK
SC
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
SC–1
SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
C099154
(a) Disconnect the height control tube.
(1) Pinch "A" of the connector No. 1 and pull out
from the housing.
“A”
Housing
WHEN LIFTING UP VEHICLE
(a) When jacking up or lifting up, stop operation of the
air suspension control system by pressing the
height control OFF switch.
DISCONNECTION AND CONNECTION OF HEIGHT
CONTROL TUBE
NOTICE:
• Disconnection and connection of the height
control tube should be performed by hand to
prevent foreign objects from entering.
• Never damage the height control tube.
Air Tube
Connector No. 1
C125294E01
(2) Set the SST to the tube.
SST 09730-00010
SST
Air Tube
C125295E01
Connector No. 2
Plate
O-ring
Air Tube
SST
C125296E01
(3) Insert SST into the housing to expand the claw
of the connector No. 2 in the housing.
(4) Pull out the tube with SST inserted.
NOTICE:
Do not pull on the tube with excessive force.
(5) Insert a screwdriver into the circular hole on the
housing, and remove the connector No. 2, the 2
O-rings and the plate from the housing.
HINT:
The O-rings, plate and connector No. 2 are nonreusable parts.
SC
SC–2
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Install height control tube O-ring and the plate.
NOTICE:
When replacing the parts on which the tube to
be installed with a new one, it is not necessary
to perform the procedure for installation.
(1) Apply MP grease to 2 new O-rings and plate and
install them to the straight tube or an equivalent.
NOTICE:
Install the plate between the O-rings.
Keep foreign matter from adhering to the Orings and the height control tube in order to
prevent air leaks.
O-ring
Plate
C125408E01
O-ring
(2) Insert the tube on which the 2 O-rings and plate
are installed into the housing, and then push it in
lightly with a piece of rolled up cardboard.
Cardboard
SC
Plate
C125409E01
(3) Push the connector No. 2 into the housing to
where a clicking sound is heard.
Connector No. 2
C125410E01
Housing
Port (Hole)
Claw
Connector
No. 1
Air Tube
C125297E01
3.
(c) Install the height control tube.
(1) Push the tube and connector No. 1 into the
housing to where a clicking sound is heard.
NOTICE:
• The port (hole) of the housing should be
set in the position 90° from the claws of
connector No. 1.
• Pull the tube lightly to make sure that it is
securely connected.
• Prevent foreign matter from being
attached to the O-rings and height control
tube. Failure to do so may cause air
leakage.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR CENTER UNIT AND
SHOCK ABSORBER
(a) Replacement of each unit is allowed if there is no oil
leakage. But, in case of oil leakage from the system,
replace both the absorber and the center unit as a
set.
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL SYSTEM
4.
(b) For replacement of the system, make it possible to
replace a unit only at the first time and replace the
system as a set of delivery at the second time or
later.
(c) When carrying each unit, be sure to hold the body of
the unit and never hang the body by holding joint
parts or hoses.
Also, do not deform metal tubes.
(d) Each unit should not be at a high temperature at the
time of replacement.
(e) Since the shock absorber could be damaged by a
sudden temperature change as being disconnected
from the center unit, be careful about its storage.
(f) Do not loosen the union bolt except the time of the
disposal of each unit.
(g) Never loosen the absorber hoses and the flare nuts
at the joint parts.
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION PRECAUTION FOR
CENTER UNIT AND SHOCK ABSORBER
(a) Conduct the operations as stretching all the shock
absorbers out by jacking up the vehicle.
(b) Never put a great compressive load to the shock
absorbers, such as contacting the tires on the
ground, before connecting them to the center unit to
avoid the break down.
(c) Avoid the contacting surfaces of the joint parts to get
any foreign objects, and wipe them away so as not
to damage the O-rings in case of the adhesion.
(d) Be sure to fit the detentes attached to the bracket on
the front absorber hose side, the rear absorber hose
side and the middle unit joint part into a hole on the
frame side.
(e) Never loosen the absorber hoses and the flare nuts
at the joint parts.
(f)
G020407
SC–3
For the joint that is connecting the supplied parts,
tighten the joint as checking the gap spacing shown
in the illustration.
Dimension of gap:
1 mm (0.04 in.)
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
SC
SC–57
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1774/74 Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When turning the ignition switch to the ON position, the battery positive voltage is input to terminal B and
IG of the suspension control ECU. By turning the ignition switch to OFF, the supply of the battery positive
voltage to terminal B and IG terminals stops, and the power is turned OFF.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
The terminal B or IG voltage is detected being
below or above a constant voltage for 0.5
seconds.
C1774/74
Battery
Power source circuit
Suspension control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side J/B
I18
Ignition SW
2 AM1
ECU-IG
2
1C
L-Y
IG1 4
Suspension Control ECU
12
1E
J4
J/C
B-R
B-R
F
F
SC
10
S15 IG
Engine Room R/B
L-Y
AIR SUS No. 2
2
AIR SUS
1
6
S14 B
GR
2
2
2
2
W-L
1
ALT
2
2
2
B
AM1
1
2
2
B
1
J/C
2
W-B
A
J2
A
J3
A
J3
W-B
W-B
1
S15 GND
5
S14 GND2
Battery
EB
F045204E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT SOURCE VOLTAGE
(a) Check the battery voltage.
SC–58
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 2 when using the
intelligent tester, and start from step 3 when not using
the intelligent tester.
NG
REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
INSPECT FUSE (AIR SUS NO.2)
(a) Remove the AIR SUS No. 2 fuse from the engine room
R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the AIR SUS No. 2 fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room R/B:
SC
NG
REPLACE FUSE
AIR SUS
No. 2
Fuse
F043247E05
OK
3
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the ECU-IG fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Driver Side J/B:
NG
ECU-IG
Fuse
F043250E02
OK
REPLACE FUSE
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
4
SC–59
INSPECT SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
S15
GND (-)
(a) Remove the suspension control ECU with connectors
still connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and measure voltage
between terminal S14-6 (B) and S15-1 (GND) and
between terminal S14-6 (B) and S14-5 (GND2) of the
suspension control ECU connector.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
S14
B (+)
GND2 (-)
F043242E02
IG (+)
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON, measure voltage between
terminals S15-10 (IG) and S15-1 (GND) and between
terminals S15-10 (IG) and S14-5 (GND2) of the
suspension control ECU connector.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
S15
S14
GND (-)
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
GND2 (-)
F043242E03
NG
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
GND2
S15
GND
S14
F043248E01
(a) Disconnect the suspension control ECU connectors.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and measure the resistance
between terminal S15-1 (GND) and body ground and
between terminal S14-5 (GND2) and body ground.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
• OK:
Repair or replace the harness or the connector
between the AIR SUS fuse and the suspension
control ECU and/or the ECU-IG fuse and the
suspension control ECU.
• NG:
Repair or replace the harness or the connector
between the suspension control ECU and body
ground.
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC
SC–60
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1776/76 Speed Sensor Circuit
DTC
C1794/94 Front Speed Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1795/95 Front Speed Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects the wheel speed and transmits the appropriate vehicle speed signal to the
suspension control ECU through the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
C1776/76
SC
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Speed sensor circuit malfunction.
Speed sensor
Speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU
Suspension control ECU
HINT:
When DTC C1794/94 and C1795/95 are output, follow the same procedure as DTC1776/76.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Suspension Control ECU
38
FLO S28
L-O
8
S15 FLO
37
FRO S28
L-R
9
S15 FRO
F050633E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the intelligent tester, and start from step 2 when not using the
intelligent tester.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–61
(c) Select the item "VEHICLE SPEED" in the DATA LIST,
and read its value displayed on the intelligent tester.
(d) Check that there is no difference between the speed
value output from the speed sensor displayed on the
intelligent tester and the speed value displayed on the
speedometer when driving the vehicle.
OK:
There is almost no difference in the displayed
speed values.
HINT:
There is tolerance of +-10% in the speedometer
indication.
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK DTC (VSC SYSTEM)
(a) Check if the normal code is output by VSC (See page
BC-48).
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - SKID CONTROL
ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the suspension control ECU and the
skid control ECU (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
INSPECT SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU (FLO SIGNAL, FRO SIGNAL)
(a) Remove the suspension control ECU with connector still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Connect an oscilloscope to between terminals S15-8
(FLO) and S15-1 (GND) and between terminals S15-9
(FRO) and S15-1 (GND) of the suspension control ECU
harness side connector.
S15
GND
FRO
FLO
F043242E04
SC
SC–62
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
5 V/Division
5 ms/Division
F044951E02
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
SC
(d) Drive the vehicle with about 20 km/h (12 mph), and
check the signal waveform.
OK:
Signal waveform appears as shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
As the engine speed becomes higher, the waveform
cycle gets shorter.
NG
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC–63
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1779/79 Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit
DTC
C1797/97 Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The suspension control ECU receives the engine speed signal from ECM.
DTC No.
C1779/79
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
TACH signal is not sent to suspension control ECU, and
the vehicle is driven for 10 sec. or more at the speed of
30 km/h or higher.
•
•
•
•
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ECM
Suspension control ECU
HINT:
When DTC C1797/97 is output, follow the same procedure as that of DTC1779/79.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Suspension Control ECU
ECM
1
TACH E7
B-W
F
J32
J/C
G
J31
J8
J/C
B-W
B-W
F
F
13
IC5
B-W
13
S14 TACH
F043231E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the suspension control ECU and
ECM (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
SC
SC–64
2
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM (TACH SIGNAL)
E6
E1
(a) Remove the ECM with connectors being connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Connect an oscilloscope to terminals E7-1 (TACH) and
E6-1 (E1) of the ECM harness side connector.
E7
TACH
I034219E17
Normal Signal Waveform
About
13 V
SC
GND
5 V/Division
(d) With the engine idling, check the signal waveform.
Standard:
Signal waveform appears as shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
As the engine speed becomes higher, the waveform
cycle gets shorter.
NG
10 ms/Division
F044950E04
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPLACE ECM
SC–65
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1782/82 Stop Light Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light comes on and the signal is input to the STP terminal of
the suspension control ECU.
HINT:
This DTC is output only when the sensor signal check is done.
DTC No.
C1782/82
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
The signal from the stop light switch assembly does
not change.
Stop light switch assembly
Stop light switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
SC
Suspension Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
STOP LP CTRL Relay
2
To Battery
1
2
2
J4 J/C
G-W
2
5
G-B
2
3
G-B
E
E
12
S14 STP
4
G-Y
G-Y
B
B
S12 Stop Light SW
2
B
ALT
STOP
2
2
1
2
2
1
G-W 2
1
2
2
B
G-W
Battery
F050636E01
SC–66
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STOP LIGHT
(a) Check that the stop light comes on when the brake pedal
is depressed and goes off when the brake pedal is
released.
OK:
Stop light operates normally.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
INSPECT SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
(a) Remove the suspension control ECU with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage between terminal S14-12 (STP) of
the suspension control ECU and body ground when the
stop light switch is ON and OFF.
Standard voltage
SC
S14
STP (+)
Switch condition
Specified condition
Brake pedal depressed (ON)
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal released (OFF)
Below 1 V
F043242E05
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
3
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the stop light switch assembly connector.
(b) Check resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the stop
light switch assembly.
Standard resistance
1
Free
2
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed in
E065594E53
OK
Switch condition
NG
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH
SC–67
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
4
INSPECT SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
(a) Remove the suspension control ECU with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage between terminal S14-12 (STP) of
the suspension control ECU and body ground when the
stop light switch is ON and OFF.
Standard voltage
S14
Switch condition
STP (+)
Specified condition
Brake pedal depressed (ON)
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal released (OFF)
Below 1 V
F043242E05
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC
SC–68
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1783/83 Door Courtesy Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The door courtesy light switch turns on when the door is opened and turns off when the door is closed.
The signal is sent from the body ECU and the back door ECU into the DOOR terminal of the suspension
control ECU when all the doors are open.
DTC No.
C1783/83
DTC Detecting Condition
Door courtesy light switch signal
does not change.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
Door courtesy light switch
Back door lock assembly (Back door courtesy light switch)
Door courtesy light switch circuit
Body ECU
Back door ECU
Suspension control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
SC
Body ECU
20
ACTY B5
Suspension Control ECU
12
IC5
R-G
R-G
4
S15 DOOR
F043233E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
(a) Check that the open door warning light comes on when
any door or back door is opened and goes off when all
the doors are closed.
OK:
Courtesy light operates normally.
NG
OK
CHECK OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
SC–69
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - BODY ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the suspension control ECU and the
body ECU (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT BODY ECU (ACTY OUTPUT)
(a) Remove the body ECU with connectors still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage between terminal B5-20 (ACTY) of
the body ECU and body ground when door is opened
and closed.
Standard voltage
B5
ACTY (+)
Door condition
Specified condition
Each door opened
Below 1.5 V
All doors closed
10 to 14 V
F044280E01
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPLACE BODY ECU
SC
SC–70
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1786/86 Height Control Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Vehicle height can be chosen by pressing the height control switch.
By pressing the "UP" side, vehicle height goes up.
By pressing the "DOWN" side, vehicle height goes down.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1786/86
Height control switch signal does not change.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Height control switch
Height control switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
H12
Height Control SW
SC
Suspension Control ECU
L
10
IC5
L
16
S14 UPSW
L-W
9
IC5
L-W
15
S14 DNSW
HSW 3
W-B
6 E
LOSW 5
A
J24
J/C
II
F043234E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the intelligent tester and start from step 2 when not using the
intelligent tester.
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (HEIGHT SW DOWN AND HEIGHT SW UP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and turn the intelligent tester
main switch ON.
(c) Select the item "HEIGHT SW DOWN" or "HEIGHT SW
UP" in the DATA LIST, and read its value displayed on
the intelligent tester.
(d) Check that the value displayed on the intelligent tester
changes by pressing the height control switch "UP" or
"DOWN".
SC–71
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
OK:
Height control switch value changes.
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
NG
2
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Remove the height control switch connector.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of the height
control switch when the height control switch "UP" or
"DOWN" button is pressed.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
6
3
5
UP Button
Height Control Switch
NG
Switch condition
Specified condition
2-3
"UP" button
Below 1 Ω
2-3
"DOWN" button
10 kΩ or higher
2-4
"UP" button
10 kΩ or higher
2-4
"DOWN" button
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
DOWN
Button
F043252E01
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEIGHT CONTROL SWITCH - SUSPENSION
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the height control switch and the
suspension control ECU (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC
SC–72
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1788/88 Height Control OFF Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Height control can be operated or suspended by pressing the height control OFF switch.
By pressing the switch once, height control can be suspended.
By pressing the switch one more time, height control can be operated.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Height control OFF switch signal does not
change.
C1788/88
•
•
•
Height control OFF switch
Height control OFF switch circuit
Suspension control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
H19
Height Control Mode Select SW
(Height Control OFF Switch)
SC
W-B
G
4
HEIGHT
OFF
CONTROL
3
Suspension Control ECU
11
IC5
G
24
S14 TD
A
J24
J/C
II
F043235E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the intelligent tester and start from step 2 when not using the
intelligent tester.
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (HEIGHT SW HOLD)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and turn the intelligent tester
main switch ON.
(c) Select the item "HEIGHT SW HOLD" in the DATA LIST,
and read its value displayed on the intelligent tester.
(d) Check that the value displayed on the intelligent tester
changes by pressing the height control mode select
switch.
OK:
Height control mode select switch value changes.
SC–73
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
NG
2
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL OFF SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the height control OFF switch connector.
(b) Check continuity between terminals 3 and 4 of the height
control mode select switch when the height control OFF
switch is pushed in and free.
Standard resistance
3
Switch condition
Specified condition
Pushed in
Below 1 Ω
Free
10 kΩ or higher
4
Height Control OFF
Switch
NG
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL OFF SWITCH
SC
Pushed In
Free
C123983E02
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEIGHT CONTROL OFF SWITCH - SUSPENSION
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the height control OFF switch and
the suspension control ECU (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC–74
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Height Control Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The height control indicator light indicates the target height, not the actual height.
It blinks when the height control is operated by pressing the height control switch and stays on when the
operation is completed.
SC
SC–75
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Suspension Control ECU
Combination Meter Assembly
DRIVE
CIRCUIT
15
C10
R-L
LO
4
C8
BR-B
3
IC5
BR-B
18
S15 LO
N
3
C8
Y-B
2
IC5
Y-B
17
S15 NR
HI
2
C8
Y
1
IC5
Y
16
S15 HI
OFF
5
C8
Y-G
4
IC5
Y-G
15
S15 VN
13
C10
BR
7
IM1
16
C10
R
F
J9
J/C
H
J8
J7 J/C
R
R
D
D
Driver Side J/B
GAUGE
4
1G
W
2
6
1D
1
2
6 IG2
2
1
AM2 7
R
2
R
2
Battery
Short Pin
2
C2
IC4
B-R
DOME
2
BR
I18 Ignition SW
AM2
1
SC
2
B
ED
Engine Room R/B
F050634E01
SC–76
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the height control indicator light comes on.
OK:
Height control indicator light comes on, and then
goes off after 2 seconds.
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the suspension control ECU and the
combination meter (See page IN-38).
SC
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC–19
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• If a normal system code is displayed during the DTC check
but the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each
problem symptom in the order given in the table below and
proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
• Inspect the fuse before inspecting the suspected areas as
shown in the chart below.
• Inspect each malfunction circuit in numerical order for the
corresponding symptom.
• If the malfunction still exists even after checking and
confirming that all the circuits are normal, replace the
suspension control ECU.
AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Symptom
Vehicle height control function does not operate.
Illuminated position of height control indicator light
does not change by height control switch operation.
Hunting of vehicle height occurs.
Vehicle height control operates, but vehicle height
uneven.
Vehicle height control operates, but vehicle height
height or low (Vehicle height in NORMAL mode differs
from standard value).
Suspected area
See page
1. Freezing of the air tube
-
2. Power source circuit
SC-52
3. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
SC-60
4. Height control OFF switch circuit
SC-69
5. Height control switch circuit
SC-67
6. Height control sensor circuit
SC-30
7. Height control solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
8. Gate solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
9. Exhaust solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
10. AIR SUS relay circuit
SC-40
11. Height control compressor circuit
SC-44
12. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Power source circuit
SC-54
2. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
SC-60
3. Height control OFF switch circuit
SC-69
4. Height control switch circuit
SC-67
5. Height control sensor circuit
SC-35
6. Height control solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
7. Gate solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
8. Exhaust solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
9. AIR SUS relay circuit
SC-40
10. Height control compressor circuit
SC-44
11. Speed sensor circuit
SC-57
12. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Air leakage (Height control cylinder assembly rear)
SC-28
2. Height control sensor circuit
SC-30
3. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Air leakage
SC-28
2. Clogging of air tube
-
3. Height control sensor link sub-assembly
-
4. Height control sensor circuit
SC-30
5. Gate solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
6. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Height control sensor link sub-assembly
-
2. Height control sensor circuit
SC-30
3. Suspension control ECU
-
SC
SC–20
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Symptom
When vehicle height control adjusted, it stops at
extremely high or low position.
Height control manual indicator light condition
abnormal.
Height control indicator light condition abnormal.
DTC check cannot completed.
SC
Input signal check (test mode) cannot completed.
Vehicle height extremely low when vehicle parked. (*1)
Compressor motor continues to operate. (*2)
Suspected area
See page
1. Height control sensor circuit
SC-30
2. Height control sensor link sub-assembly
-
3. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Power source circuit
SC-52
2. Height control OFF switch circuit
SC-69
3. Height control manual indicator light circuit
SC-74
4. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Power source circuit
SC-52
2. Height control indicator light circuit
SC-71
3. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Power source circuit
SC-52
2. TC terminal circuit
SC-78
3. Height control OFF light circuit
SC-74
4. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Power source circuit
SC-52
2. TS terminal circuit
SC-80
3. Suspension control ECU
-
1. Air leakage
SC-28
2. Height control cylinder assembly rear
-
3. Height control sensor link sub-assembly
-
4. Height control solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
5 Exhaust valve circuit
SC-35
1. Air leakage
SC-28
2. Air tube clogged
-
3. Height control cylinder assembly rear
-
4. Height control sensor link sub-assembly
-
5. Height control solenoid valve circuit
SC-35
6. Exhaust valve circuit
SC-35
7. Tank solenoid valve circuit
-
8. AIR SUS relay circuit
SC-40
9. Height control compressor circuit
SC-44
10. Suspension control ECU
-
HINT:
• *1: Although, especially in a cold district, the vehicle height
may become lower due to the air temperature drop in the
height control cylinder assembly, that is not abnormal.
• *2: Due to the air tube freezing, vehicle may not rase all
the time.
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–77
Height Control OFF Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
If the suspension control ECU detects a problem, the height control OFF indicator light comes on while
suspending the height control function at the same time. At the same time, the suspension control ECU
records a DTC in the memory.
Connect terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 to make the height control manual indicator light blink and
output DTCs.
SC
SC–78
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Suspension Control ECU
Combination Meter Assembly
DRIVE
CIRCUIT
15
C10
R-L
SC
LO
4
C8
BR-B
3
IC5
BR-B
18
S15 LO
N
3
C8
Y-B
2
IC5
Y-B
17
S15 NR
HI
2
C8
Y
1
IC5
Y
16
S15 HI
OFF
5
C8
Y-G
4
IC5
Y-G
15
S15 VN
13
C10
BR
7
IM1
16
C10
R
F
J9
J/C
H
J8
J7 J/C
R
R
D
D
Driver Side J/B
GAUGE
4
1G
W
2
6
1D
B-R
6 IG2
1
2
2
1
R
2
Battery
Short Pin
2
AM2 7
R
2
DOME
2
C2
IC4
I18 Ignition SW
AM2
1
BR
2
B
ED
Engine Room R/B
F050634E01
SC–79
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the height control manual indicator light
comes on.
OK:
Height control manual indicator light comes on,
and then goes off after 2 seconds.
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the suspension control ECU and the
combination meter (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
3
CHECK CONNECTORS
(a) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
suspension control ECU.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear and check the DTC (See page SC-23).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Normal system code is output.
A
DTC is output.
B
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
SC
SC–80
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the suspension control ECU and the
combination meter (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC–81
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
DTC is output when there is a short circuit between terminals TC and CG of DLC3.
WIRING DIAGRAM
D1
DLC3
Suspension Control ECU
J18
J/C
TC
13
P-L
H
H
5
IC5
P-L
P-L
6
S15 TC
J22
J/C
CG
4
W-B
E
W-B
E
SC
J5
J/C
A
IG
F043237E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DLC3 TERMINAL VOLTAGE (TC TERMINAL)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals TC and CG of
DLC3.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
TC
OK
Go to step 3
DLC3 CG
B124401E92
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between terminal CG of DLC3 and body
ground (See page IN-38).
SC–82
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between terminal TC of DLC3 and the
suspension control ECU (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
SC
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC–9
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SUSPENSION CONTROL
& AXLE
PARTS LOCATION
AIR SUS FUSE
ENGINE ROOM R/B NO. 4:
SUSPENSION
CONTROL RELAY
AIR SUS FUSE NO. 2
SC
ENGINE ROOM R/B:
ENGINE ROOM R/B NO. 4
ENGINE ROOM R/B
RIGHT FRONT
SPEED SENSOR
LEFT FRONT SPEED SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
C131560E01
SC–10
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
ECU-IG FUSE
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY:
DRIVER SIDE J/B:
SC
SKID CONTROL ECU ASSEMBLY
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
SUSPENSION
CONTROL ECU
ECM
HEIGHT CONTROL
OFF SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE J/B
DLC3
COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BODY ECU
HEIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
C119708E01
SC–11
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
HEIGHT CONTROL
SENSOR LINK
SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
HEIGHT CONTROL
CYLINDER
ASSEMBLY REAR
SC
HEIGHT CONTROL
RESERVOIR
ASSEMBLY
HEIGHT CONTROL VALVE
HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
LEVELING SOLENOID
VALVE
DRYER
BACK DOOR ECU
WITH MOTOR BACK
DOOR ASSEMBLY
TANK SOLENOID VALVE
CYLINDER RH
CYLINDER LH
COMPRESSOR
HEIGHT
CONTROL
DRYER
ASSEMBLY
EXHAUST SOLENOID VALVE
GATE SOLENOID VALVE
C119709E01
SC–83
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
TS and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
After making short circuit between terminal TS and CG of DLC3 with the ignition switch is turned to the
OFF position, the mode will change from normal mode to test mode when the ignition switch is turned to
the ON position, and then DTC is output. After the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, there will be
DTC output.
WIRING DIAGRAM
D1
DLC3
Suspension Control ECU
TS
4
IC2
R-B
12
J4
J/C
R-B
D
R-B
D
5
S15 TS
J22
J/C
CG
W-B
4
E
SC
W-B
E
J5
J/C
A
IG
F050635E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DLC3 TERMINAL VOLTAGE (TS TERMINAL)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals TS and CG of
DLC3.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
TS
OK
DLC3 CG
B124401E93
NG
Go to step 3
SC–84
2
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between terminal CG of DLC3 and body
ground (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between terminal TS of DLC3 and the
suspension control ECU (See page IN-38).
SC
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC–84
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
REMOVAL
SC
1.
REMOVE REAR DISC WHEEL
2.
REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
3.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER (See page ET-10)
4.
REMOVE FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE PROTECTOR
(a) Remove the 4 clips and the fuel tank filler pipe
protector.
5.
REMOVE SPARE DISC WHEEL
6.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR COVER
(a) Remove the 3 clips and the height control
compressor cover.
7.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL FILTER
(a) Disconnect the 2 clips and the 2 hoses.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the height control filter.
8.
DISCONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2
(a) Remove the holder.
(b) Spread the clip and slowly pull the height control
tube No. 2 straight out.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the clip from the union except
when replacing it.
(c) Remove the 2 O-rings.
9.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 clamps.
C099145
C099146
(c) Remove the 3 bolts.
(d) Disconnect the clip and remove the No. 1 hose.
C099147
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
SC–85
(e) Remove the 3 bolts, the height control compressor
and the dryer with the bracket.
(f) Remove the bolt, the dryer and the O-ring.
(g) Remove the 3 bushings from the height control
compressor assembly.
C099148
SC
SC–86
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
INSTALLATION
SC
1.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 3 bushings to the height control
compressor assembly.
(b) Install the bolt, the dryer and the new O-ring.
Torque: 6.4 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 57 in.*lbf)
(c) Assemble the height control compressor, the dryer
and the bracket as a unit to the vehicle, and tighten
the 3 bolts to fix the bracket to the frame.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the height control compressor assembly to
the bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.9 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 52 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the 3 clamps.
(f) Connect the connector.
(g) Connect the No. 1 hose with a new clip.
2.
CONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2
(a) Coat 2 new O-rings with MP grease.
(b) Push the height control tube No. 2 in straight to
connect it until the clip makes "click" sound.
NOTICE:
Do not get scratches or foreign particles on the
O-ring, O-ring seal and flare section.
(c) Install the holder.
3.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL FILTER
(a) Install the height control filter with the new 2 bolts.
Torque: 6.4 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 57 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect 2 new clips and 2 hoses.
4.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR COVER
(a) Install the height control compressor cover with 3
new clips.
5.
CHECK AIR LEAK
6.
INSTALL SPARE DISC WHEEL
7.
INSTALL FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE PROTECTOR
(a) Install the fuel tank filler pipe protector with the 4
clips.
8.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER (See page ET-14)
9.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
10. INSTALL REAR DISC WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
SC–88
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
REMOVAL
SC
1.
REMOVE REAR DISC WHEEL
2.
REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
3.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER (See page ET-10)
4.
REMOVE FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE PROTECTOR
(See page SC-84)
5.
REMOVE SPARE DISC WHEEL
6.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR COVER
(See page SC-84)
7.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL FILTER (See page SC84)
8.
DISCONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2 (See
page SC-84)
9.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts.
C099147
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, the height control compressor
and the dryer with the bracket.
(d) Remove the bolt and the dryer.
(e) Remove the O-ring.
C099148
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
SC–89
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the bolt, the dryer and a new O-ring.
Torque: 6.4 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 57 in.*lbf)
(b) Assemble the height control compressor, the dryer
and the bracket as a unit to the vehicle, and tighten
the 3 bolts to fix the bracket to the frame.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the height control compressor assembly to
the bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.9 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 52 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the connector.
2.
CONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2 (See page
SC-85)
3.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL FILTER (See page SC85)
4.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR COVER
(See page SC-85)
5.
CHECK AIR LEAK (See page SC-28)
6.
INSTALL SPARE DISC WHEEL
7.
INSTALL FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE PROTECTOR
(See page SC-85)
8.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER (See page ET-14)
9.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
10. INSTALL REAR DISC WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
SC
SC–92
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE SPARE DISC WHEEL
2.
DISCONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2
(a) Remove the holder.
(b) Spread the clip and slowly pull the height control
tube No. 2 straight out.
(c) Remove the 2 O-rings.
3.
DISCONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 6
(a) Using SST, disconnect the height control tube No. 6.
SST 09730-00010
NOTICE:
Refer to PRECAUTION of removal and
installation of the height control tube (See page
SC-1).
(b) Remove the 2 O-rings, the plate and the plug.
4.
DISCONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 7
(a) Using SST, disconnect the height control tube No. 7.
SST 09730-00010
NOTICE:
Refer to PRECAUTION of removal and
installation of the height control tube (See page
SC-1).
(b) Remove the 2 O-rings, the plate and the plug.
5.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the height control reservoir
assembly.
SC
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
SC–93
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the height control reservoir assembly with the
2 bolts.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
2.
CONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 7
(a) Install 2 new O-rings, a new plate, a new plug and
connect the height control tube No. 7.
NOTICE:
Refer to PRECAUTION of removal and
installation of the height control tube (See page
SC-1).
3.
CONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 6
(a) Install 2 new O-rings, a new plate, a new plug, and
connect the height control tube No. 6.
NOTICE:
Refer to PRECAUTION of removal and
installation of the height control tube (See page
SC-1).
4.
CONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2
(a) Coat 2 new O-rings with MP grease.
(b) Push the height control tube No. 2 in straight to
connect it until the clip makes "click" sound.
(c) Install the holder.
5.
CHECK AIR LEAK (See page SC-28)
6.
INSTALL SPARE DISC WHEEL
SC
SC–96
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
INSTALLATION
SC
1.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Install the height control sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(b) Align the matchmarks on the link and the bracket.
(c) Connect the sensor link with the nut.
(d) Connect the connector to the height control sensor.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR DISC WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
3.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT (See page SP-4)
4.
ADJUST VEHICLE HEIGHT (See page SC-6)
SC–100
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REMOVAL
SC
G020175
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-9)
3.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IP9)
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 1 (See page IP-9)
5.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE (See
page IP-9)
6.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-8)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
8.
REMOVE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
(a) Disconnect the 3 suspension control ECU
connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the suspension control
ECU.
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC–101
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
(a) Install the suspension control ECU with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 3 suspension control ECU connectors.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
5.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 1
6.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
SC
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–21
TERMINALS OF ECU
S15
S14
S13
F043241E03
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
SLRL (S13-1) - GND (S15-1)
V-W - W-B
SLRR (S13-2) - GND (S15-1)
V - W-B
SLLO (S13-7) - GND (S15-1)
P-G - W-B
SLEX (S13-8) - GND (S15-1)
LG - W-B
RC (S13-18) - GND (S15-1)
BR-Y - W-B
Condition
Specified
Condition
IG switch ON
Below 1.0 V
Engine idling, button of height control switch is pushed from
"N" to "UP" or "DOWN"
8 V or more
IG switch ON
Below 1.0 V
Engine idling, button of height control switch is pushed from
"N" to "UP" or "DOWN"
8 V or more
IG switch ON
Below 1.0 V
Engine idling, button of height control switch from "UP" to
"DOWN"
8 V or more
IG switch ON
Below 1.0 V
Engine idling, button of height control switch from "UP" to
"DOWN"
8 V or more
IG switch ON
Below 1.0 V
Engine idling, button of height control switch is pushed from
"N" to "UP" or "DOWN"
8 V or more
SGR2 (S13-19) - GND (S15-1)
GR - W-B
Always
Below 1 Ω
SBR2 (S13-20) - GND (S15-1)
G-R - W-B
IG switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
Always
Below 1 Ω
IG switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
IG switch ON
0.5 to 4.5 V
SGL2 (S13-21) - GND (S15-1)
R-W - W-B
SBL2 (S13-22) - GND (S15-1)
BR-W - W-B
SHRL (S13-23) - GND (S15-1)
GR-G - W-B
SHRR (S13-24) - GND (S15-1)
W - W-B
RM+ (S13-25) - GND (S15-1)
O - W-B
Engine idling, vehicle height is changing from "NORMAL" to
"HIGH" by pressing the height control switch (While height
control compressor assembly is working).
RM- (S13-26) - GND (S15-1)
P - W-B
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 (S14-5) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
B (S14-6) - GND (S15-1)
GR - W-B
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
STP (S14-12) - GND (S15-1)
G-B - W-B
TACH (S14-13) - GND (S15-1)
B-W - W-B
Engine idling
L-W - W-B
IG switch ON, "DOWN" button of height control switch pushed
in
Engine idling, vehicle height is changed from "HIGH" to
"NORMAL" by pressing the height control switch
IG switch ON
DNSW (S14-15) - GND (S15-1)
Engine idling, vehicle height is changed from "HIGH" to
"NORMAL" by pressing the height control switch
Brake pedal depressed
Brake pedal released
IG switch ON, "DOWN" button of height control switch free
UPSW (S14-16) - GND (S15-1)
L - W-B
IG switch ON, "UP" button of height control switch pushed in
IG switch ON, "DOWN" button of height control switch free
Approx. 2.5 V
0.5 to 4.5 V
Approx. 2.5 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.5 V
Pulse generation
Below 1.5 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.5 V
10 to 14 V
SC
SC–22
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
TD (S14-24) - GND (S15-1)
G - W-B
GND (S15-1) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
DOOR (S15-4) - GND (S15-1)
TS (S15-5) - GND (S15-1)
SC
R-G - W-B
R-B - W-B
TC (S15-6) - GND (S15-1)
P-L - W-B
FLO (S15-8) - GND (S15-1)
L-O - W-B
Specified
Condition
Condition
IG switch ON, height control OFF switch push in
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON, height control OFF switch released
10 to 14 V
Below 1 Ω
Always
IG switch ON, each door opened
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON, all door closed
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and terminals TS - CG connected
Below 1.0 V
IG switch ON and terminals TS - CG not connected
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and terminals TC - CG connected
Below 1.0 V
IG switch ON and terminals TC - CG not connected
10 to 14 V
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or higher
Pulse generation
Pulse generation
FRO (S15-9) - GND (S15-1)
L-R - W-B
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph) or higher
IG (S15-10) - GND (S15-1)
B-R - W-B
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
MOD2 (S15-11) - GND (S15-1)
W-B - W-B
Always
Below 1 Ω
MOD1 (S15-12) - GND (S15-1)
W-B - W-B
Always
Below 1 Ω
VN (S15-15) - GND (S15-1)
Y-G - W-B
HI (S15-16) - GND (S15-1)
Y - W-B
NR (S15-17) - GND (S15-1)
Y-B - W-B
LO (S15-18) - GND (S15-1)
BR-B - W-B
SIL (S15-20) - GND (S15-1)
R-Y - W-B
IG switch ON, height control OFF indicator light ON
8 V or more
IG switch ON, height control OFF indicator light OFF
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON, height control "HI" indicator light ON
8 V or more
IG switch ON, height control "N" or "LO" indicator light ON
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON, height control "N" indicator light ON
8 V or more
IG switch ON, height control "LO" or "HI" indicator light ON
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON, height control "LO" indicator light ON
8 V or more
IG switch ON, height control "HI" or "N" indicator light ON
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON
8 V or more
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
DLC3:
1.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
F100115E31
Symbols (Terminal No.)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
(a) Inspect the battery voltage.
Battery voltage:
11 to 14 V
If voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before
proceeding.
(b) Check DLC3.
The suspension control ECU uses the ISO 9141-2
for communication. The terminal arrangement of the
DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the
ISO 9141-2 format.
Verify the conditions listed in the table below:
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During communication
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
HINT:
If the intelligent tester display shows UNABLE TO
CONNECT TO VEHICLE when the cable of the
intelligent tester is connected to the DLC3, the
ignition switch is turned ON and the tester is
operated, there is a problem on the vehicle side or
tester side.
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–23
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tester itself, so consult the
service department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
(c) DTCs (Normal mode)
(1) DTCs are memorized in the suspension control
ECU and read by using the SST check wire or
the intelligent tester (See page SC-23).
SST 09843-18040
(d) Test mode (Input signal check)
(1) By switching from normal mode into test mode,
you can inspect the height control switch, height
control mode select switch, door courtesy light
switch, and stop light switch (See page SC-13).
(e) Check the indicator light.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) Check that the height control manual indicator
light and the height control indicator light come
on for 2 seconds.
If the indicator check result is not normal,
proceed to troubleshooting for the height control
indicator light circuit (See page SC-71) and the
height control OFF indicator light circuit (See
page SC-74).
F041674
DLC3:
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
CG
1.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
CHECK DTC (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Checking DTCs using the SST check wire.
SST 09843-18040
(1) Using the SST, connect terminals TC and CG of
the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
F100115E02
(3) Read and record any DTCs from the height
control OFF indicator light on the combination
meter.
F041674
SC
SC–24
Normal:
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(4) As examples, the blinking patterns of a normal
system code and codes 13 and 33 are shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
• If the height control OFF indicator light does
not blink any DTC or a normal system code,
inspect the height control OFF indicator light
circuit (See page SC-74) and the TC terminal
circuit (See page SC-78).
• If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the
same time, the lowest numbered DTC is
displayed first.
(5) Refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart (See
page SC-26) for DTC information.
(6) After completing the check, remove the SST
check wire from the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
Codes 13 and 33: 1.5 sec.
0.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
4.5 sec.
ON
OFF
SC
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
Repeat
C123990E01
DLC3:
(b) Clearing the DTCs using the SST check wire.
SST 09843-18040
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
F100115E02
(3) Clear DTCs stored in the ECU by depressing the
brake pedal 8 times or more within 5 seconds.
(4) Check that the height control OFF indicator light
shows a normal system code.
(5) Remove the SST check wire from the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
HINT:
Disconnecting the battery cable during the
operation will not erase DTCs in the ECU.
F042949
2.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
A066288E03
CHECK DTC (USING INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(a) Checking DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Read DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
(b) Clearing the DTCs using the intelligent tester.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–25
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Erase the DTCs following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
SC
SC–82
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
SUSPENSION &
CONTROL
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SC
REAR BUMPER
SPARE DISC
WHEEL
QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR LH
FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE PROTECTOR
C119695E01
SC–83
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
HEIGHT CONTROL FILTER
SC
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
CLIP
CLIP
29 (300, 21)
HEIGHT CONTROL
TUBE NO. 2
HOSE NO. 1
BRACKET
CLIP
HOSE
BUSHING
29 (300, 21)
5.9 (60, 52 in.*lbf)
29 (300, 21)
HOLDER
HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR COVER
O-RING
BUSHING
BUSHING
O-RING
5.9 (60, 52 in.*lbf)
CLIP
CLIP
CLIP
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
ASSEMBLY
HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131576E01
SC–26
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
SC
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) In the normal operation, if there is short or open in
the sensor etc., the suspension control ECU
suspend the vehicle height control operation.
SC–27
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
By accessing the DATA LIST displayed by the intelligent
tester, you can read the value of the switches and
sensors and so on without removing any parts. Reading
the DATA LIST is the first step of troubleshooting and is
one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Following the display on the tester, read the DATA
LIST.
AIR SUSPENSION
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed reading / min.: 0 km/
h (0 mph), max.: 255 km/h (158
mph)
Actual vehicle speed
IG VOLTAGE
ECU power supply voltage / min.: 0
V, max.: 25.5 V
Actual ECU power supply voltage: 10 to
14 V
ENGINE SPD
Cam position sensor reading / min.:
0 rpm, max.: 25,500 rpm
Actual engine revolutional speed
HEIGHT SW DOWN
Height control switch (DOWN) / ON
or OFF
ON: Height control switch "DOWN"
button pressed
OFF: -
-
HEIGHT SW UP
Height control switch (UP) / ON or
OFF
ON: Height control switch "UP" button
pressed
OFF: -
-
HEIGHT SW HOLD
Height control mode select switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Height control mode select switch
pressed
OFF: -
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch / ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
DOOR SW
Door courtesy light switch / ON or
OFF
ON: Open each door
OFF: Close all doors
-
DAMPER SW1
Damping force switch 1 / ON or
OFF
The same as height control switch
position
TS
TS terminal / ON or OFF
ON: During test mode
OFF: Normal mode
-
TC
TC terminal / ON or OFF
ON: DTC recorded
OFF: No DTC recorded
-
SOL SLRL
Height control valve solenoid
(SLRL) / ON or OFF
ON or OFF
-
SOL SLRG
Height control valve solenoid
(SLRG) / ON or OFF
ON or OFF
-
LOW PRS TNK SOL
Tank solenoid valve (SLLO) / ON or
OFF
ON or OFF
-
MOTOR RELAY
AIR SUS relay / ON or OFF
ON: Compressor operated
OFF: Compressor not operated
-
EXHAUST SOL
Exhaust solenoid valve (SLEX) /
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
-
RR HEIGHT
Right rear height control sensor
reading / min.: -3276.7 mm (129.004 in.), max.: 3276.8 mm
(129.008 in.)
Min.: -20 mm (-0.79 in.)
Max.: 40 mm (-1.57 in.)
-
Speed indicated on the
speedometer
Engine revolutional speed
indicated on the combination
meter
Operate the height control
switch
SC
SC–28
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Item
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
RL HEIGHT
Left rear height control sensor
reading / min.: -3276.7 mm (129.004 in.), max.: 3276.8 mm
(129.008 in.)
Min.: -20 mm (-0.79 in.)
Max.: 40 mm (1.57 in.)
-
#CODES
Number of DTC recorded / min.: 0,
max.: 255
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
2.
SC
ACTIVE TEST LIST
HINT:
Perform the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester to
operate the sensors, relays and solenoids without
removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST is the
first step of troubleshooting and is one of the methods to
shorten labor time. It is possible to display the DATA
LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Following the display on the tester, perform the
ACTIVE TEST.
AIR SUSPENSION
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
RR HEIGHT
Turn height control switch / UP or DOWN
MOTOR RELAY
Turn AIR SUS relay / ON or OFF
-
EXHAUST SOL
Turn exhaust solenoid valve / ON or OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
LEVEL SOL REAR
Turn leveling solenoid valve / ON or OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
GATE SOL REAR
Turn gate solenoid valve / ON or OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
LOW PRS TNK SOL
Turn tank solenoid valve / ON or OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of motor can be heard
SC–86
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
SUSPENSION &
CONTROL
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SC
REAR BUMPER
SPARE DISC
WHEEL
QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR LH
FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE PROTECTOR
C119695E01
SC–87
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
HEIGHT CONTROL FILTER
SC
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
CLIP
CLIP
29 (300, 21)
HEIGHT CONTROL
TUBE NO. 2
HOSE NO. 1
BRACKET
CLIP
HOSE
BUSHING
29 (300, 21)
5.9 (60, 52 in.*lbf)
29 (300, 21)
HOLDER
HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR COVER
O-RING
BUSHING
BUSHING
O-RING
5.9 (60, 52 in.*lbf)
CLIP
CLIP
CLIP
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
HEIGHT CONTROL DRYER
ASSEMBLY
HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131576E01
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–29
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
• Inspect the fuse before inspecting the suspected areas as
shown in the chart below.
• If no abnormality is found when the parts are inspected,
inspect the suspension control ECU.
• If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the circuit listed for that code. For details of each code,
refer to the "See page" in the table below.
AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
OFF Indicator
Light (*1)
Memory (*2)
See page
C1713/13
Right Rear Height
Control Sensor
Circuit
1. Height control sensor subassembly rear RH
2. Right rear height control sensor
circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on (*3)
DTC stored
SC-30
C1714/14
Left Rear Height
Control Sensor
Circuit
1. Height control sensor subassembly rear LH
2. Left rear height control sensor
circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on (*3)
DTC stored
SC-30
C1733/33
Rear Height
Control Gate
Solenoid Valve
Circuit Malfunction
1. Gate solenoid valve
2. Gate solenoid valve circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-35
C1734/34
Rear Height
Control Leveling
Solenoid Valve
Circuit Malfunction
1. Leveling solenoid valve
2. Leveling solenoid valve circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-35
C1735/35
Exhaust Solenoid
Valve Circuit
1. Exhaust solenoid valve
2. Exhaust solenoid valve circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-35
C1741/41
Air Suspension
Relay Circuit
1. AIR SUS relay
2. AIR SUS relay circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-40
C1742/42
Height Control
Compressor Circuit
1. Height control compressor
assembly
2. Height control compressor
circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-44
C1744/44
Tank Solenoid
Valve Circuit
1. Tank solenoid valve
2. Tank solenoid valve circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-35
C1751/51 (*4)
Continuous
Electric Current to
Height Control
Compressor
1. Height control compressor
assembly
2. Height control compressor
circuit
3. Height control sensor link subassembly rear
4. Height control sensor subassembly rear
5. Relief valve
6. AIR SUS relay comes off
7. Air leakage from the air tube or
each valve
8. Clogging in the air tube or each
valve
9. Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-49
C1761/61
ECU Malfunction
Suspension control ECU
Comes on
DTC stored
SC-52
SC
SC–30
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
OFF Indicator
Light (*1)
Memory (*2)
See page
C1774/74
Power Source
Circuit
1. Battery
2. Power source circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-54
C1776/76
Speed Sensor
Circuit
1. Speed sensor
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Skid control ECU
4. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-57
C1794/94
Front Speed
Sensor RH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Right front speed sensor
2. Right front speed sensor circuit
3. Skid control ECU assembly
4. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-57
C1795/95
Front Speed
Sensor LH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Left front speed sensor
2. Left front speed sensor circuit
3. Skid control ECU assembly
4. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-57
C1779/79
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Circuit
1. Crankshaft position sensor
2. Crankshaft position sensor
circuit
3. ECM
4. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-60
C1797/97
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Circuit
1. Crankshaft position sensor
2. Crankshaft position sensor
circuit
3. ECM
4. Suspension control ECU
Goes off
DTC stored
SC-60
C1782/82
Stop Light Switch
Circuit
1. Stop light switch assembly
2. Stop light switch circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
SC-62
C1783/83
Door Courtesy
Switch Circuit
1. Door courtesy light switch
assembly
2. Back door lock assembly (Back
door courtesy light switch)
3. Door courtesy light switch
circuit
4. Body ECU
5. Back door ECU
6. Suspension control ECU
SC-65
C1786/86
Height Control
Switch Circuit
1. Height control switch
2. Height control switch circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
SC-67
C1788/88
Height Control
OFF Switch Circuit
1. Height control OFF switch
(Suspension control switch)
2. Height control OFF switch
circuit
3. Suspension control ECU
SC-69
SC
HINT:
• *1: For codes marked with a "Comes on" in the "OFF
Indicator Light" column, the height control manual indicator
light blinks at 1 second intervals.
• *2: The codes marked with a "DTC stored" in the
"Memory" column are stored in the memory even when the
ignition switch is OFF, but the codes marked with "-" are
not.
• *3: Height control OFF indicator light blinks when the
vehicle speed is at 3 km/h (1.9 mph) or higher.
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–31
• *4: Since the relief pressure of the compressed air is 980
kPa (10 kgf*cm2, 142 psi), if the vehicle height control is
attempted on a steeply sloping road, when the vehicle is
overloaded, or when the vehicle is jacked up with the
engine running, code "C1751/51" may be output and the
vehicle height control may be suspended (This is not
abnormal). In this case, however, the vehicle height
operation is resumed approx. 10 min. after the ignition
switch is turned ON after the ECU detects the first error. If
ECU detects another error , it takes 70 minutes until the
vehicle height control is resumed.
SC
SC–90
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
SUSPENSION &
CONTROL
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SC
SPARE DISC
WHEEL
C119695E02
SC–91
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
SC
SPARE DISC WHEEL
HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 2
CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR
HOLDER
CLIP
O-RING
29 (300, 21)
O-RING
PLUG
29 (300, 21)
PLATE
PLATE
HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 7
O-RING
HEIGHT CONTROL
RESERVOIR ASSEMBLY
PLUG
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
HEIGHT CONTROL TUBE NO. 6
C119696E01
SC–32
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK FLUID LEAKAGE
(a) Check the connections of tube and parts for fluid
leakage.
SC
: Supply parts only
C099149E01
SC–33
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1713/13
Rear Height Control Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1714/14
Rear Height Control Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Inside the sensor, a brush integrated with the control sensor rotor shaft moves above the resistor,
providing linear output. Since the resistance value between the brush and resistor terminal changes in
proportion to the shaft rotation angle, the fixed voltage applied to the resistor by ECU is modified by the
sensor and output to the ECU as a voltage indicating the shaft rotation angle.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
C1713/13
With the ignition switch ON, a voltage of 4.7 V or more or 0.3 V or less at
each height control sensor sub-assembly rear is detected for 1 sec.
C1714/14
•
•
•
•
•
Height control sensor sub-assembly rear
RH
Right rear height control sensor circuit
Suspension control ECU
Height control sensor sub-assembly rear
LH
Left rear height control sensor circuit
Suspension control ECU
HINT:
• Once the ECU stores DTC C1713/13 or C1714/14 in the memory, vehicle height control is suspended
and not carried out until a normal signal is input to the ECU from the height control sensor subassembly. However, the control resumes if the ignition switch is turned OFF, and then turned ON again.
• When the suspension control ECU detects a malfunction in the height control sensor, the height control
indicator light "N" comes on or blinks, and the height control switch ("HI" and "LO") is suspended.
• When either one of the right or left height control sensor sub-assembly is faulty, the suspension control
ECU uses the other one (functioning one) to adjust the vehicle height to the normal height. When both
of the height control sensor sub-assembly are faulty, the suspension control ECU suspend the height
control function immediately.
SC
SC–34
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
H15 Height Control Sensor Rear LH
SHB
SHRL
SHG
Suspension Control ECU
BR-W
22
BC2
BR-W
22
S13 SBL2
GR-G
17
BC2
GR-G
23
S13 SHRL
R-W
11
BC2
R-W
21
S13 SGL2
G-R
9
BC2
G-R
20
S13 SBR2
W
18
BC2
W
24
S13 SHRR
GR
19
BC2
GR
19
S13 SGR2
1
2
3
H16 Height Control Sensor Rear RH
SC
SHB
SHRR
SHG
1
2
3
F043223E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Proceed to troubleshooting following the flow chart, regardless of whether or not DTC C1713/13 or
C1714/14 is displayed.
• If DTC C1761/61 (ECU malfunction) and/or C1774/74 (power source circuit) is displayed, perform the
inspection necessary for DTC C1761/61 (See page SC-52) and/or C1774/74 (See page SC-54) first.
(If DTC C1761/61 and C1774/74 are output at the same time, perform the inspection necessary for
DTC C1774/74 first.)
• Start the inspection from step 1 when using the intelligent tester, and start from step 2 when not using
the intelligent tester.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
SC–35
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(c) Select the item "RL HEIGHT" or "RR HEIGHT" in the
DATA LIST, and read its value displayed on the
intelligent tester.
(d) Check the vehicle height value of the height control
sensor sub-assembly with the intelligent tester while
pressing the height control switch "UP" or "DOWN".
OK:
Vehicle height value changes.
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the height control sensor sub-assembly rear
LH and RH connectors.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage:
LH Side
RH:
LH:
H16
H15
SHB
SHG
SHB
SHG
F044277E01
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
H15-1 (SHB) - H15-3
(SHG)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
H16-1 (SHB) - H16-3
(SHG)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
RH Side
OK
Go to step 4
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR REAR SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the S13 suspension control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
LH Side
Tester connection
Specified condition
S13-22 (SBL2) - H15-1 (SHB)
Below 1 Ω
S13-23 (SHRL) - H15-2 (SHRL)
Below 1 Ω
S13-21 (SGL2) - H15-3 (SHG)
Below 1 Ω
S13-22 (SBL2) - S13-23 (SHRL)
10 kΩ or higher
S13-21 (SGL2) - S13-23 (SHRL)
10 kΩ or higher
S13-21 (SGL2) - S13-22 (SBL2)
10 kΩ or higher
RH Side
SC
SC–36
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Tester connection
Specified condition
S13-20 (SBR2) - H16-1 (SHB)
Below 1 Ω
S13-24 (SHRR) - H16-2 (SHRR)
Below 1 Ω
S13-19 (SGR2) - H16-3 (SHG)
Below 1 Ω
S13-20 (SBR2) - S13-24 (SHRR)
10 kΩ or higher
S13-19 (SGR2) - S13-24 (SHRR)
10 kΩ or higher
S13-19 (SGR2) - S13-20 (SBR2)
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Remove the height control sensor sub-assembly rear LH
or RH.
(b) Connect 3 dry batteries of 1.5 V in series.
(c) Height control sensor sub-assembly rear LH:
Connect terminal 1 (SHB) to the batteries' positive (+)
terminal, and terminal 3 (SHG) to the batteries' negative
(-) terminal, then apply approximately 4.5 V between
terminal 2 (SHRL) and 3 (SHG) in the following
conditions.
Standard voltage
Low
SC
Normal
High
LH:
(+)
2
1
3
(-)
(-)
RH:
Voltage
High (0° to 45°)
Approx. 2.53 to 4.33 V
Normal (0°)
Approx. 2.53 V
Low (0° to -45°)
Approx. 0.81 to 2.53 V
Result
(+)
2
3
(-)
Position
(+)
(+)
1
(-)
F044307E01
Result
Proceed to
OK
A
NG
B
(d) Height control sensor sub-assembly rear RH:
Connect terminal 1 (SHB) to the batteries' positive (+)
terminal, and terminal 3 (SHG) to the batteries' negative
(-) terminal, then apply approximately 4.5 V between
terminal 1 (SHG) and 2 (SHRR) in the following
conditions.
Standard voltage
Position
Voltage
High (0° to 45°)
Approx. 2.53 to 4.33 V
Normal (0°)
Approx. 2.53 V
Low (0° to -45°)
Approx. 0.81 to 2.53 V
Result
Result
Proceed to
OK
A
NG
C
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SC–37
B
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
C
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY REAR RH
A
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC
SC–94
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
SUSPENSION &
CONTROL
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SC
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
BRACKET
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
13 (133, 10)
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR LH
BRACKET
13 (133, 10)
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAL RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C134076E01
SUSPENSION CONTROL – HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
SC–95
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR DISC WHEEL
2.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Disconnect the connector from the height control
sensor.
(b) Place matchmarks on the link and bracket.
(c) Remove the nut and disconnect the sensor link.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and height control sensor.
Matchmarks
G020167E01
SC
SC–38
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1733/33
Rear Height Control Gate Solenoid Valve Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1734/34
Rear Height Control Leveling Solenoid Valve
Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1735/35 Exhaust Solenoid Valve Circuit
DTC
C1744/44 Tank Solenoid Valve Circuit
DESCRIPTION
SC
The suspension control ECU opens the height control valve to lead the compressed air to the height
control cylinder (pneumatic cylinder) and to raise the vehicle height.
When the vehicle height is lowered, the suspension control ECU opens the height control valve to store
the compressed air in the low pressure tank temporarily, and then operates the exhaust solenoid valve to
release the compressed air to the outside.
Further, the height control solenoid valve (gate solenoid valve) opens and closes the passage between
the right and left pneumatic cylinder.
The height control valve is on the low pressure tank and consists of 3 valves in total, leveling solenoid
valve, gate solenoid valve and tank solenoid valve.
The leveling solenoid valve opens and closes the passage between the compressor and the pneumatic
cylinder. The gate solenoid valve opens and closes the passage between the right and left pneumatic
cylinder. The tank solenoid valve opens and closes the passage between pneumatic cylinder and the low
pressure tank. The exhaust solenoid valve is on the compressor unit and has only one valve.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1733/33
C1734/34
C1735/35
C1744/44
Either the condition 1. or 2. is detected:
1. With the height control solenoid valve (or exhaust solenoid valve)
inactivated, an open signal of the height control solenoid valve is
detected for 1 sec. or more.
2. With the height control solenoid valve (or exhaust solenoid valve)
activated, a short signal of the valve is detected 8 times successively.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Gate solenoid valve
Gate solenoid valve circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Leveling solenoid valve
Leveling solenoid valve circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Exhaust solenoid valve
Exhaust solenoid valve circuit
Suspension control ECU
•
•
•
Tank solenoid valve
Tank solenoid valve circuit
Suspension control ECU
HINT:
• Once the ECU stores DTC C1733/33, C1734/34, C1735/35 or C1744/44 in the memory, the vehicle
height control is suspended out until a normal signal is input to the ECU from the height control
solenoid valves and the exhaust solenoid valve. However, control is resumed if the ignition switch is
turned OFF, then ON again.
• Malfunction in the gate solenoid valve and the leveling solenoid valve:
The height control operation is suspended, and the height control indicator light does not change by
operating the height control switch.
• Malfunction in the exhaust solenoid valve:
The vehicle height is lowered to the normal height within 30 sec., and then the height control operation
is suspended. The height control indicator light "N" comes on or blinks, and that of "HI" and "LO" do not
illuminated by operating the height control switch "UP" and "DOWN".
• Abnormality of the tank solenoid valve:
Although the height control is still possible, the vehicle lowering speed may be slower.
SC–39
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
L1 Low Pressure Tank Valve
(Tank Solenoid Valve)
W-B
1
2
Suspension Control ECU
12
BC2
P-G
7
S13 SLLO
V-W
14
BC2
V-W
1
S13 SLRL
V
13
BC2
V
2
S13 SLRR
15
BC2
LG
8
S13 SLEX
P-G
H17 Height Control Valve (Gate Solenoid
Valve and Leveling Solenoid Valve)
LH+
W-B
2
W-B
W-B
E
2
RH+
1
1
3
LG
SC
H13 Height Control Compressor
(Exhaust Solenoid Valve)
BN
F050617E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Proceed to troubleshooting following the flow chart, regardless of whether or not DTC C1733/33,
C1734/34, C1735/35 or C1744/44 is displayed.
• If DTC C1761/61 (ECU malfunction) and/or C1774/74 (power source circuit) is displayed, perform the
inspection necessary for DTC C1761/61 (See page SC-52) and/or C1774/74 (See page SC-54) first.
(If DTC C1761/61 and the C1774/74 are output at the same time, perform the inspection necessary for
DTC C1774/74 first.)
• Start the inspection from step 1 when using the intelligent tester, and start from step 2 when not using
the intelligent tester.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item "LEVEL SOL REAR", "GATE SOL
REAR", "LOW PRS TNK SOL", "EXHAUST SOL" in the
ACTIVE TEST, and operate it with the intelligent tester.
(d) Check whether the solenoid makes sound.
(e) Check whether the height control valve has continuity
(will vibrate).
SC–40
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
OK:
The solenoid makes sound, and the height control
valve has continuity (will vibrate).
OK
NG
SC
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC–41
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
2
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL VALVE OR EXHAUST SOLENOID VALVE
(a) Disconnect the valve connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Gate Solenoid Valve:
Leveling Solenoid Valve:
Solenoid valve
Gate solenoid valve
3
2
Exhaust Solenoid Valve:
1
1
Gate Solenoid Valve:
Leveling Solenoid Valve:
(+)
3
2
1
(-)
10 to 14 Ω
1-2
10 to 14 Ω
Tank solenoid valve
1-2
10 to 14 Ω
2
Battery positive
Battery negative
Gate solenoid valve
1
2
Leveling solenoid valve
3
2
Exhaust solenoid valve
1
2
Tank solenoid valve
2
1
NG
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
ASSEMBLY
NG
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL
COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
(+)
Tank Solenoid Valve:
1
(+)
2-3
Exhaust solenoid valve
OK:
It should make an operating sound (click).
HINT:
• When a malfunction is found in the gate solenoid
valve, the leveling valve or the tank solenoid valve,
replace the height control reservoir assembly.
• When a malfunction is found in the exhaust solenoid
valve, replace the height control compressor
assembly.
(-)
Exhaust Solenoid Valve:
2
17.5 to 21.5 Ω
Leveling solenoid valve
Solenoid valve
1
Specified condition
1-2
HINT:
The height control solenoid valve has 2 connectors.
• The gate solenoid valve and the leveling solenoid
valve have a 3-pole connector.
• Tank solenoid valve connector has a 2-pole
connector.
(c) Check the operating sound of the valves when battery
positive voltage is applied to the terminals as shown
below.
Tank Solenoid Valve:
2
Tester connection
(-)
F044511E01
SC
SC–42
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connectors between height control solenoid valve or the
exhaust solenoid valve and the suspension control ECU
(See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC–96
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SUSPENSION &
CONTROL
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SC
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
C131332E02
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC–97
SC
INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
B120190E06
SC–98
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER
INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PLATE
SC
B120191E08
SUSPENSION CONTROL – SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC–99
SC
SUSPENSION
CONTROL ECU
C119708E02
SC–43
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
C1741/41 Air Suspension Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the "UP" side of the height control switch is pressed, a signal is sent from terminal RC of the
suspension control ECU to the AIR SUS relay to turn it on.
As a result, the current flows to the AIR SUS relay coil, closing the relay contact, and then the battery
positive voltage is applied to the compressor, which causes the compressed air to raise the vehicle height.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1741/41
Either of the following conditions is detected:
1. With the AIR SUS relay inactivated, an open signal of the AIR SUS
relay is detected for 1 sec. or more.
2. With the AIR SUS relay activated, a short signal of the AIR SUS
relay is detected 8 times successively.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
AIR SUS relay
AIR SUS relay circuit
Suspension control ECU
HINT:
Once the ECU stores DTC C1741/41 in the memory, the vehicle height control is suspended until a
normal signal is input to the ECU from the AIR SUS relay. However, the control resumes if the ignition
switch is turned OFF, and then turned ON again.
SC
SC–44
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Suspension Control ECU
Engine Room R/B No. 4
AIR SUS Relay
W-B
SC
To Height Control
Compressor
Assembly
4
1
IB1
L-B
4
2
1
3
5
4
18
S13 RC
5
BR-Y
IB2
BR-Y
4
Engine Room R/B
B
AIR SUS
ALT
2
2
1
2 1
2
L-Y
2
2
B
J2 B
J/C
J3 B
W-B
Battery
EB
F050631E01
SC–45
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTC C1761/61 (ECU malfunction) and/or C1774/74 (power source circuit) is displayed, perform the
inspection necessary for DTC C1761/61 (See page SC-52) and/or C1774/74 (See page SC-54) first.
(If DTC C1761/61 and C1774/74 are output at the same time, perform the inspection necessary for
DTC C1774/74 first.)
• Start the inspection from step 1 when using the intelligent tester, and start from step 2 when not using
the intelligent tester.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item "MOTOR RELAY" in the ACTIVE TEST,
and operate it with the intelligent tester.
(d) Check the operating sound of the AIR SUS relay when
operating it with the intelligent tester.
OK:
The operating sound of the AIR SUS relay can be
heard.
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
NG
2
INSPECT AIR SUS RELAY
1
(a) Remove the AIR SUS relay from the engine room R/B
No. 3.
(b) Measure the resistance between each terminal of the
AIR SUS relay.
Standard resistance
3
1
3
5
2
2
Tester connection
Resistance
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1-2)
4
5
C123965E01
NG
REPLACE AIR SUS RELAY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ENGINE ROOM R/B - SUSPENSION CONTROL
ECU)
(a) Check for an open or short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the AIR SUS relay and the
suspension control ECU (See page IN-38).
OK:
There is no open or short in the wire harness.
SC
SC–46
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(b) Check for an open circuit in the harness and the
connector between the AIR SUS relay and the body
ground.
OK:
There is no open in the wire harness.
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
SC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
DTC
SC–47
C1742/42 Height Control Compressor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the "UP" side of the height control switch is pressed, a signal is sent from terminal RC of the
suspension control ECU to switch the AIR SUS relay ON. As a result, the relay contacts close and the
compressor motor turns on, producing compressed air.
The suspension control ECU detects the amount of current flow to the compressor motor by means of the
differences in potential at terminals RM+ and RM- of the suspension control ECU. In this way, the
suspension control ECU monitors the compressor circuit for abnormalities.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1742/42
With the AIR SUS relay activated, a lock, open or short
signal of the height control compressor motor is detected
for 4 sec. or more.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Height control compressor assembly
Height control compressor circuit
Suspension control ECU
HINT:
Once the ECU stores DTC C1742/42 in the memory, the vehicle height control is not carried out until the
normal signal is input to the ECU from the compressor motor. However, the control automatically resumes
approx. 70 min. after the ignition switch is turned ON.
SC
SC–48
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Suspension Control ECU
5
IB2
BR-Y
Engine Room R/B No. 4
SC
4
5
1
W-B
4
2
1
IB1
L-B
4
3
18
S13 RC
H14 Height Control Motor (Height
Control Compressor Assembly)
AIR SUS Relay
4
BR-Y
L-B
1
20
L-B
O
BC1
B RM+
BC2
1
3
21
W-B
P
E RMBC2
2
4
O
25
S13 RM+
P
26
S13 RM-
Engine Room R/B
L-Y
AIR SUS
ALT
2
2
2
2
1
2
B
1
J/C
2
J2
B
J3
B
W-B
B
Battery
EB
BN
F050632E01
SC–49
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Check if the other DTC is recorded (See page SC-23).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Other DTC is not output.
A
Other DTC is output.
B
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
A
2
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
2 (-)
1 (+)
F043249E01
(a) Disconnect the height control compressor assembly
connector.
(b) Apply battery voltage between terminal 1 and 2 of the
height control compressor assembly.
Standard:
Compressor motor operates.
NOTICE:
• Do not operate the height control compressor
assembly 90 sec. or more.
• Since short and lock inside the height control
compressor assembly causes enormous current
to flow, stop the operation immediately when it
dose not rotate.
NG
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL
COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the height control compressor
assembly and the suspension control ECU (See page
IN-38).
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SC
SC–50
4
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEIGHT CONTROL COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY AIR SUS RELAY)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the height control compressor
assembly and the AIR SUS relay (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
SC
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OR EXHAUST SOLENOID VALVE
(a) When using intelligent tester:
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON, and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(3) Select the item "LEVEL SOL REAR", "GATE SOL
REAR", "LOW PRS TNK SOL", "EXHAUST SOL",
in the ACTIVE TEST, and operate it with the
intelligent tester.
(4) Check whether the solenoid makes sound.
(5) Check whether the height control solenoid valve has
a continuity (will vibrate).
OK:
The solenoid makes sound, the height control
solenoid valve has a continuity (will vibrate).
SC–51
SUSPENSION CONTROL – AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
(b) When not using intelligent tester:
(1) Disconnect the valve connector.
(2) Check the operating sound of the valves when
battery positive voltage is applied to the terminals as
shown below.
Gate Solenoid Valve:
Leveling Solenoid Valve:
(+)
3
Solenoid valve
1
2
(-)
Exhaust Solenoid Valve:
2
1
2
Leveling solenoid valve
3
2
Exhaust solenoid valve
1
2
Tank solenoid valve
2
1
OK:
It should make an operating sound (click).
HINT:
• When a malfunction is found in the gate solenoid
valve, the leveling valve or the tank solenoid
valve, replace the height control reservoir
assembly.
• When a malfunction is found in the exhaust
solenoid valve, replace the height control
compressor assembly.
(+)
Tank Solenoid Valve:
2
1
(+)
Battery negative
Gate solenoid valve
1
(-)
Battery positive
(-)
NG
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL RESERVOIR
ASSEMBLY
NG
REPLACE HEIGHT CONTROL
COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
F044510E01
OK
6
CHECK AIR TUBE CLOGGED
(a) Check visually for clog, damage or breakage on the air
tube (See page SC-28).
NG
OK
REPLACE SUSPENSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR TUBE
SC
SP–3
SUSPENSION – SUSPENSION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to find the cause of the problem. The
numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause of the
problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace
these parts.
FRONT SUSPENSION:
Symptom
Bottoming
Sways/pitches
Front wheel shimmy
Abnormal tire wear
Suspected area
See page
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
-
2. Spring (Weak)
SP-10
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
SP-10
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Stabilizer bar (Bent or broken)
SP-28
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
SP-10
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Wheel (Out of balance)
TW-1
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
SP-10
4. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
5. Ball joint (Worn)
SP-22
SP
6. Hub bearing (Worn)
AH-1
7. Steering linkage (Loose or worn)
-
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
SP-10
4. Suspension parts (Worn)
-
REAR SUSPENSION:
Symptom
Wander/pulls
Bottoming
Sways/pitches
Rear wheel shimmy
Abnormal tire wear
Suspected area
See page
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
3. Hub bearing (Worn)
AH-26
4. Suspension parts (Worn)
-
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
-
2. Spring (Weak)
SP-30
3. Shock absorber (Worn) (with REAS)
SP-33
4. Shock absorber (Worn) (without REAS)
SP-38
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Stabilizer bar (Bent or broken)
SP-53
3. Shock absorber (Worn) (with REAS)
SP-33
4. Shock absorber (Worn) (without REAS)
SP-38
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Wheel (Out of balance)
TW-1
3. Shock absorber (Worn) (with REAS)
SP-33
4. Shock absorber (Worn) (without REAS)
SP-38
5. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
5. Hub bearing (Worn)
AH-26
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
3. Shock absorber (Worn) (with REAS)
SP-33
4. Shock absorber (Worn) (without REAS)
SP-38
5. Suspension parts (Worn)
-
SP–12
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
12. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT SUBASSEMBLY LH
13. REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER CUSHION
RETAINER
14. REMOVE FRONT COIL SPRING LH
15. REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER BUSH
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the absorber bush.
SST 09710-22021 (09710-01071, 09710-01081)
SST
C099164E01
INSPECTION
1.
SP
C099163
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY FRONT
LH
(a) Compress and extend the shock absorber rod, and
check that there is no abnormal resistance or
unusual sound during operation.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock
absorber assembly front LH with a new one.
NOTICE:
When disposing of the shock absorber
assembly front LH, see DISPOSAL (See page
SP-15).
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER BUSH
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new absorber
bush.
SST 09710-22021 (09710-01071, 09710-01081)
2.
INSTALL FRONT COIL SPRING LH
(a) Using SST, compress the front coil spring LH.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00031),
09727-00060
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the
SST.
(b) Install the front coil spring LH to the shock absorber
assembly front LH.
HINT:
Fit the lower end of the front coil spring LH into the
gap of the spring lower seat.
3.
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER CUSHION
RETAINER
SST
C099164E01
SST
C099165E01
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
LH
Front
SP–13
4.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT SUBASSEMBLY LH
5.
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER CUSHION NO.
1
6.
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER CUSHION
RETAINER
7.
INSTALL FRONT SUPPORT TO FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER NUT
(a) Align the suspension support sub-assembly and the
absorber bush as shown in the illustration.
(b) Tighten the new lock nut.
Torque: 25 N*m (260 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the
shock absorber rod.
(c) Release the coil spring while checking the position
of the suspension support.
8.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING (w/o REAS)
(a) Install the coil spring on the body as the lower end
of the coil spring faces rear side of the vehicle.
RH
Absorber Bush
Suspension Support Sub-assembly
C099166E01
Lower End
Outer Side
Rear Side
G021681E01
(b) Install the 3 nuts on the upper side of the front shock
absorber with coil spring.
Torque: 64 N*m (650 kgf*cm, 47 ft.*lbf)
C099160
(c) Temporarily tighten the bolt, the nut and the washer
as shown in the illustration.
C099159
SP
SP–14
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
9.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING (w/ REAS)
(a) Install the coil spring on the body as the lower end
of the coil spring faces rear side of the vehicle.
Lower End
Outer Side
Rear Side
G021681E01
(b) Install the 3 nuts on the upper side of the front shock
absorber with coil spring.
Torque: 64 N*m (650 kgf*cm, 47 ft.*lbf)
SP
C099160
(c) Temporarily tighten the bolt, the nut and the washer
as shown in the illustration.
C099159
(d) Install the bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be sure to fit the detents attached to the bracket
into a hole on the frame side.
G020405
Turn
(e) As shown in the illustration, tighten the nut of
clearance to standard value.
Clearance:
1 mm (0.04 in.)
Torque: Reference torque
25 N*m (260 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
Hold
10. INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT
G020406E01
11. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 2 LH
(See page SP-29)
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SP–15
12. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 1 RH
(See page SP-29)
13. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the stabilizer link with the nut to the
steering knuckle.
Torque: 70 N*m (710 kgf*cm, 52 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
C099158
14. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
15. INSTALL FRONT DISC WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
16. STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) Jack down the vehicle.
(b) Bounce the vehicle up and down several times to
stabilize the suspension.
17. FULLY TIGHTEN FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(a) Fully tighten the nut.
Torque: 135 N*m (1,380 kgf*cm, 100 ft.*lbf)
18. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
HINT:
(See page SP-4)
C099159
SP
SP–16
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Dispose the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
1.
DISPOSE OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
FRONT LH (w/o REAS)
(a) Fully extend the shock absorber piston rod, and fix it
at a tilt in a vise or similar tool.
(b) Using a drill or similar tool, slowly make a hole at
approx. 5 cm from the top end of the shock
absorber, and discharge the gas inside of it.
CAUTION:
• The gas is colorless, odorless and harmless.
• Since the discharged gas may cause chips to
fly off, cover the drill with a shop rag when
making a hole.
2.
DISPOSE OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
FRONT LH (w/ REAS)
(a) Before the disposal, loosen the nut slowly to breed
out the oil and to lower the pressure inside the
absorber.
NOTICE:
Never loosen the nut of the eye union except the
time of disposal.
Approximately
50 mm (1.97 in.)
G021673E01
SP
G022707
SP–24
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
INSPECTION
1.
G021680
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER NO. 1 LH
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud
back and forth 5 times, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 2 to 4 seconds per 1 turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Torque: Turning torque
3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf) or less
(c) Check for any cracks and grease leaks on the ball
joint dust cover.
INSTALLATION
1.
SST
SP
SST
Bush Positioning Protrusion
G020166E01
INSTALL FRONT LOWER ARM BUSH NO. 2 LH
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new lower arm
bush No. 2 LH.
SST 09710-26010 (09710-05081), 09950-60020
(09951-00890)
NOTICE:
Press the lower arm bush No. 2 in the lower arm
at the bush positioning protrusions become
perpendicular to the lower arm as shown in the
illustration.
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
2.
SST
SP–25
INSTALL FRONT LOWER ARM BUSH NO. 1 LH
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new lower arm
bush No. 1 LH.
SST 09223-00010, 09612-30012
NOTICE:
Press the lower arm bush No. 1 in the lower arm
at the bush positioning protrusions become
parallel with the lower arm as shown in the
illustration.
Bush Positioning Protrusion
SP
G020165E01
3.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT SUSPENSION ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 1 LH
(a) Align the matchmarks on the camber adjust cam
No. 2 and toe adjust cam sub-assembly, temporarily
tighten the bolt and the nut.
(b) Install the front lower ball joint attachment LH, a new
nut and a new cotter pin.
Torque: 140 N*m (1,430 kgf*cm, 103 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
G020160E03
(c) Install the front lower ball joint attachment LH with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 60 N*m (1,630 kgf*cm, 118 ft.*lbf)
G020159
C099159
4.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(a) Install the front shock absorber with coil spring, the
bolt and the washer, and temporarily tighten the nut.
5.
INSTALL FRONT DISC WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
6.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (See page SP-15)
SP–26
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
7.
FULLY TIGHTEN FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY NO. 1 LH
(a) Fully tighten the bolt and the nut.
Torque: 135 N*m (1,380 kgf*cm, 100 ft.*lbf)
8.
FULLY TIGHTEN FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(a) Fully tighten the nut.
Torque: 135 N*m (1,380 kgf*cm, 100 ft.*lbf)
9.
INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
HINT:
(See page SP-4)
G020160
SP
C099159
SP–1
SUSPENSION – SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SUSPENSION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
This is a flow chart for vehicle pull.
START
Preliminary Check
ROAD TEST
Tire pressure
Does the vehicle pull?
Vehicle height
NO
Is the steering off center?
YES
NO
COMPLETE
YES
SP
Brake dragging
Adjust the front tie rods.
YES Are the tires a uni-directional type?
NO
NO
Interchange the front & wheel
assemblies (left & right).
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still pull?
YES
Choose the front tire and wheel
assembly position where pull is minimal.
YES Does the vehicle pull in same direction
as before?
NO
Check front wheel alignment. Is it
YES NO Is the pull stronger than before?
within specification?
NO
C
YES
C113980E04
SP–2
SUSPENSION – SUSPENSION SYSTEM
Reverse the front left side tire and
Adjust front wheel alignment.
rebalance it.
ROAD TEST
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still pull?
NO
SP
COMPLETE
NO
Does the vehicle still pull?
YES
YES
Does the vehicle pull to the left?
YES
NO
Increase right front camber and decrease left
Increase left front camber and decrease
front camber until pull is eliminated.
right front camber until pull is eliminated.
NO
ROAD TEST
YES
Contact your local retail tire distributor.
Does the vehicle still pull?
C
C113981E03
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SP–29
INSTALLATION
Bushing
Stopper
Protrusion
1.
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT
2.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO. 1
(a) Install the 2 front stabilizer bar bush No. 1.
HINT:
• Install the bushing to the inner side of the
bushing stopper on the stabilizer bar.
• Install the stabilizer bush No. 1 as the protrusion
to be on the inner side of the vehicle.
3.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 2 LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer bracket No.2 LH with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 40 N*m (410 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 1 RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by following the same procedures
with the LH side.
Outside
Frontside
G021678E04
G020162
5.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer link assembly LH with the 2
nuts.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
6.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by following the same procedures
with the LH side.
7.
INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
G020161
SP
SP–4
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
ADJUSTMENT
Front:
A
B
Rear:
1.
INSPECT TIRE
2.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
(a) Measure the vehicle height.
Vehicle height:
2WD Except air suspension
Front A - B
Rear C - D
UZN210L-GKAGKA
113.6 mm (4.47 in.)
71.7 mm (2.82 in.)
UZN210L-GKAZKA
113.5 mm (4.47 in.)
72.3 mm (2.85 in.)
GRN210L-GKPGKA
110.5 mm (4.35 in.)
70.9 mm (2.79 in.)
GRN210L-GKPZKA
110.4 mm (4.35 in.)
71.3 mm (2.81 in.)
2WD Air suspension
UZN210L-GKAZKA
Front A - B
Rear C - D
112.7 mm (4.44 in.)
81.4 mm (3.20 in.)
4WD Except air suspension
SP
D
C
D028453E01
Front A - B
Rear C - D
UZN215L-GKAGKA
99.9 mm (3.93 in.)
71.6 mm (2.82 in.)
UZN215L-GKAZKA
99.8 mm (3.93 in.)
72.1 mm (2.84 in.)
GRN215L-GKPGKA
99.8 mm (3.93 in.)
71.3 mm (2.81 in.)
GRN215L-GKPZKA
99.8 mm (3.93 in.)
71.9 mm (2.83 in.)
4WD Air suspension
UZN215L-GKAZKA
Front A - B
Rear C - D
99.2 mm (3.91 in.)
78.9 mm (3.11 in.)
Measuring points:
A:
Ground clearance of front wheel center
B:
Ground clearance of lower suspension arm
No. 2 set bolt center
C:
Ground clearance of rear wheel center
D:
Ground clearance of strut rod set bolt center
NOTICE:
Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust
the vehicle height to the specified value.
If the vehicle height is not the specified value, try to
adjust it by pushing down on or lifting the body.
SP–5
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
A
B
D
3.
Front
INSPECT TOE-IN
(a) Inspect the toe-in.
Toe-in:
A + B: 0°05' +- 0°10' (0.08° +- 0.16°)
C - D: 1 +- 2 mm (0.04 +- 0.08 in.)
Toe-in (total)
If the toe-in is not within the specified value, adjust it
at the rack ends.
4.
C
SA03213E04
ADJUST TOE-IN
(a) Remove the rack boot set clips.
(b) Loosen the tie rod end lock nuts.
(c) Turn the right and left rack ends by an equal amount
to adjust the toe-in.
HINT:
Try to adjust the toe-in to the center of the specified
value.
(d) Make sure that the lengths of the right and left rack
ends are the same.
(e) Torque the tie rod end lock nuts.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
(f) Place the boots on the seats and install the clips.
HINT:
Make sure that the boots are not twisted.
(g) Perform VSC system calibration
G020168
A
B
B
5.
A
Front
A: Inside
INSPECT WHEEL ANGLE
(a) Turn the steering wheel fully, and measure the
turning angle.
Wheel angle:
2WD
Inside wheel
Outside wheel (Reference)
37°00' (35°00' to 38°00')
37.00° (35.00° to 38.00°)
32°30'
32.50°
B: Outside
4WD
SA00028E06
Inside wheel
Outside wheel (Reference)
36°40' (34°40' to 37°40')
36.67° (34.67° to 37.67°)
32°53'
32.88°
If the wheel angles differ from the standard of the
specification, inspect the toe-in.
6.
Alignment
Tester
Gauge
INSPECT CAMBER, CASTER AND STEERING AXIS
INCLINATION
(a) Install the camber-caster-kingpin gauge or position
vehicle on wheel alignment tester.
(b) Inspect the camber, the caster and the steering axis
inclination.
Camber, caster and steering axis inclination:
2WD Except air suspension
Area
Z003382E06
Camber
Specified Condition
-0°28' +- 45' (-0.47° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
SP
SP–6
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Area
Specified Condition
3°23' +- 45' (3.38° +- 0.75°)
Caster
Right-left error
Steering axis
inclination
45' (0.75°) or less
12°58' +- 45' (12.97° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
2WD Air suspension
Area
Specified Condition
-0°30' +- 45' (-0.50° +- 0.75°)
Camber
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
3°33' +- 45' (3.55° +- 0.75°)
Caster
Right-left error
Steering axis
inclination
45' (0.75°) or less
13° 00' +- 45' (13.00° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
4WD Except air suspension
Area
-0°09' +- 45' (-0.15° +- 0.75°)
Camber
SP
Specified Condition
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
3°13' +- 45' (3.22° +- 0.75°)
Caster
Right-left error
Steering axis
inclination
45' (0.75°) or less
12°39' +- 45' (12.65° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
4WD Air suspension
Area
Specified Condition
-0°10' +- 45' (-0.17° +- 0.75°)
Camber
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
3°22' +- 45' (3.37° +- 0.75°)
Caster
Right-left error
Steering axis
inclination
45' (0.75°) or less
12°40' +- 45' (12.67° +- 0.75°)
Right-left error
45' (0.75°) or less
If the steering axis inclination is not as specified
after camber and caster have been correctly
adjusted, recheck the steering knuckle and front
wheel for distortion or looseness.
7.
ADJUST CAMBER AND CASTER
NOTICE:
After the camber has been adjusted, inspect the toein.
(a) Loosen the nut and bolt.
(b) Turn the camber adjust cam No. 2 and toe adjust
plate No. 2 in the circumference direction, and
adjust the camber and the caster.
HINT:
Try to adjust the camber and caster to the center
value.
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SP–7
Front
Front Cam (LH)
Front
FrontCam
cam (RH)
(RH)
(Longer)
(Shorter) (Shorter)
(Longer)
(Longer)
(Shorter) (Shorter)
(Longer)
Rear Cam (LH)
Rear Cam (RH)
G020169E02
(Example)
Caster
Camber
Calculated value
0 point
G020414E02
(c) How to read adjustment chart (using examples).
(1) Measure the present alignment.
Camber:
0°15' (0.25°)
Caster:
2°45' (2.75°)
(2) Make the difference between the standard
value (A) and the measured value (B) on the
adjustment chart.
Standard value:
Camber:
0°35' (0.58°)
Caster:
2°55' (2.92°)
Formula:
B-A=C
Camber:
0°15' - (0 35') = - 0°20'
Caster:
2°45' - (2°55') = - 0°10'
(3) As shown in the chart, read the distance from
the marked point to 0 point, and adjust the front
and/or rear adjusting cams accordingly.
Toe adjust cam:
- (Shorter) 2.8
Camber adjust cam:
- (Shorter) 1.8
SP
SP–8
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Front Cam
Graduation
SP
Rear Cam
Graduation
Caster
Camber
G020415E02
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
SP–35
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Install the lower bracket to the shock absorber
assembly rear LH.
(b) Install the cushion retainer, cushion No. 1 and shock
absorber assembly rear LH with the nut.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
D028457
(c) Refer to NOTICE below.
NOTICE:
• Be sure to fit the positioning protrusion of the
bracket to a hole on the frame.
• to a hole on the frame. Install the hose as it
comes in the front.
D028459
(d) Install the shock absorber assembly rear LH with
the bolt.
D028132
(e) Install the bracket with the bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
(f) Using a wrench to hold the bracket, install the joint.
HINT:
Tighten the joint so that the gap spacing becomes 1
mm (0.04 in.).
Torque: Reference
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY (See
page SP-54)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
4.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) Jack down the vehicle.
D028262
SP
SP–36
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
(b) Bounce the vehicle up and down several times to
stabilize the suspension.
5.
FULLY TIGHTEN SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
REAR LH
(a) Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 98 N*m (1,000 kgf*cm, 72 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSPECT FLUID LEAK
HINT:
(See page SC-3)
D028132
DISPOSAL
1.
SP
D028135
DISPOSE OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Loosen the bolt.
(b) Drain absorber oil.
SP–9
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
with REAS:
70 (710, 52)
Reference Torque:
25 (255, 18)
FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
29 (300, 21)
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
CUSHION RETAINER
25 (260, 18)
FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER
CUSHION NO. 1
FRONT SUSPENSION
SUPPORT
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
70 (710, 52)
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER CUSHION
RETAINER
135 (1,380, 100)
FRONT COIL SPRING LH
STABILIZER BAR FRONT
FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER BUSH
40 (410, 30)
FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT STABILIZER
BRACKET NO. 1 RH
FRONT STABILIZER
BRACKET NO. 2 LH
40 (410, 30)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119710E01
SP
SP–10
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DISC WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer link
from the steering knuckle.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
3.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by following the same procedures
with the LH side.
4.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 2 LH
5.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 1 RH
6.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR FRONT
7.
REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING (w/o REAS)
(a) Remove the bolt, the nut and the washer.
C099158
SP
C099159
(b) Remove the 3 nuts on the upper side of the front
shock absorber with coil spring.
(c) Remove the front shock absorber with coil spring.
8.
REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING (w/ REAS)
NOTICE:
Conduct the operations as stretching all the shock
absorbers out by jacking up the vehicle.
C099160
(a) As shown in the illustration, loosen the nut and
disconnect the tube.
NOTICE:
Never loosen the absorber hoses and the flare
nuts at the joint parts.
Hold
Turn
G020404E01
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SP–11
(b) Remove a bolt and the bracket.
G020405
(c) Remove a bolt, the nut and the washer.
SP
C099159
(d) Remove the 3 nuts on the upper side of the front
shock absorber with coil spring.
(e) Remove the front shock absorber with coil spring.
C099160
9.
SST
REMOVE FRONT SUPPORT TO FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER NUT
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00031),
09727-00060
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the
SST.
C099161E01
(b) Hold the shock absorber rod, remove the nut.
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the
shock absorber rod.
10. REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER CUSHION
RETAINER
11. REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER CUSHION NO.
1
C099162
SP–17
SUSPENSION – FRONT UPPER SUSPENSION ARM
FRONT UPPER SUSPENSION ARM
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT SUSPENSION
UPPER ARM BUSH LH
FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM ASSEMBLY LH
115 (1,170, 85)
WASHER
WASHER
FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER
ARM BUSH LH
SP
13 (130, 9)
5.8 (59, 51 in.*lbf)
SKID CONTROL
SENSOR WIRE
13 (130, 9)
BRACKET
110 (1,120, 81)
CLIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)
Non-reusable part
C119711E01
SP–18
SUSPENSION – FRONT UPPER SUSPENSION ARM
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DISC WHEEL
2.
INSPECT FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check that there is no looseness on the ball joint by
shaking the upper arm up and down by hand.
3.
REMOVE SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the skid control
sensor wire.
4.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Support the front suspension lower arm LH with a
jack.
(b) Remove the clip and the nut.
(c) Using SST, disconnect the upper ball joint from the
steering knuckle.
SST 09628-62011
C099168
SP
SST
G020151E02
(d) Remove the bolt and the bracket.
G020152
(e) Remove the bolt, the 2 washers and the nut.
(f) Remove the front suspension upper arm assembly.
G020153
SUSPENSION – FRONT UPPER SUSPENSION ARM
5.
SP–19
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM BUSH
LH
(a) Using a hammer and chisel, raise the flange of the
bushing diagonally as shown in the illustration.
G020154
(b) Using SST and a press remove the front suspension
upper arm bush LH (front side).
SST 09613-26010, 09710-22021 (09710-01031),
09950-00020
(c) Replace the rear side by the same procedures with
the front side.
SST
SST
SP
G020155E02
INSPECTION
1.
G020170
INSPECT FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud
back and forth 5 times, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 3 to 5 seconds per 1 turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Torque: Turning torque
4.5 N*m (46 kgf*cm, 40 in.*lbf) or less
(c) Check for any cracks and grease leaks on the ball
joint dust cover.
INSTALLATION
1.
SST
G020156E02
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM BUSH
LH
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new front
suspension upper arm bush LH (front side).
SST 09710-26010 (09710-05061)
(b) Install the rear side by the same procedures with the
front side.
SP–20
SUSPENSION – FRONT UPPER SUSPENSION ARM
2.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT SUSPENSION
UPPER ARM ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front suspension upper arm assembly,
and temporarily tighten bolt, the 2 washers and the
nut.
G020153
(b) Install the bracket with the bolt.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf)
SP
G020152
(c) Install a new nut and a new clip.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,120 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
G020157
3.
CONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
(a) Install the connect skid control sensor wire with the
2 bolts.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FRONT DISC WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,140 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
5.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (See page SP-15)
6.
FULLY TIGHTEN FRONT SUSPENSION UPPER ARM
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Fully tighten the nut.
Torque: 115 N*m (1,170 kgf*cm, 85 ft.*lbf)
7.
INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
HINT:
(See page SP-4)
C099168
G020158
SP–21
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
WITH COIL SPRING
135 (1,380, 100)
SP
CAMBER ADJUST
CAM NO. 2
CAMBER ADJUST CAM ASSEMBLY
TOE ADJUST PLATE NO. 2
135 (1,380, 100)
TOE ADJUST CAM SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT LOWER ARM
BUSH NO. 2 LH
135 (1,380, 100)
FRONT LOWER ARM BUSH NO. 1 LH
FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER NO. 1 LH
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT ATTACHMENT LH
140 (1,430, 103)
COTTER PIN
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
160 (1,630, 118)
Non-reusable part
C119712E01
SP–22
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DISC WHEEL
2.
INSPECT FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER NO. 1 LH
(a) Install the hub nuts to the disc.
(b) Using a dial indicator, check the lower ball joint for
excessive play when you push the hub nuts up and
down with a force of 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf).
Maximum:
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
HINT:
If it is not within the specification, replace the lower
arm.
3.
SEPARATE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Remove the bolt, nut and washer.
(b) Separate the front shock absorber with coil spring
from the suspension lower arm.
4.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER NO. 1 LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, and separate the front lower
ball joint attachment LH from the front axle.
G021682
SP
C099159
G020159
(b) Place matchmarks on the camber adjust cam No. 2
and toe adjust cam sub-assembly.
(c) Remove the nut, camber adjust cam No. 2, camber
adjust cam assembly, bolt, toe adjust cam subassembly, toe adjust plate No. 2 and front
suspension arm sub-assembly lower No. 1 LH.
Matchmarks
G020160E03
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SP–23
(d) Remove the cotter pin and the nut.
(e) Using SST, remove the front lower ball joint
attachment LH.
SST 09628-00011
SST
G020416E02
5.
REMOVE FRONT LOWER ARM BUSH NO. 1 LH
(a) Using a hammer and a chisel, raise the flange of the
bushing diagonally as shown in the illustration.
SP
G020164
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the lower arm bush
No. 1 LH.
SST 09632-36010, 09950-00020, 09950-60010
(09951-00400)
SST
SST
G020412E01
6.
REMOVE FRONT LOWER ARM BUSH NO. 2 LH
(a) Using a hammer and a chisel, raise the flange of the
bushing diagonally as shown in the illustration.
G020164
(b) Using SST and a press, remove the lower arm bush
No. 2 LH.
SST 09632-36010, 09950-00020, 09950-60010
(09951-00400)
SST
SST
G020413E01
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SP–27
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
70 (710, 52)
FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
SP
70 (710, 52)
70 (710, 52)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT
70 (710, 52)
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY LH
40 (410, 30)
FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO. 1
FRONT STABILIZER
BRACKET NO. 1 RH
FRONT STABILIZER
BRACKET NO. 2 LH
40 (410, 30)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119713E01
SP–28
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DISC WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and the front stabilizer link
assembly LH.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon (6 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
3.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by following the same procedures
withe the LH side.
4.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 2 LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and front stabilizer bracket No.
2 LH.
5.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO. 1 RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by following the same procedures
withe the LH side.
6.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO. 1
(a) Remove the 2 front stabilizer bar bush No. 1.
7.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR FRONT
G020161
SP
G020162
INSPECTION
1.
G021679
INSPECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud
back and forth 5 times, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 2 - 4 seconds per 1 turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Torque: 2.0 N*m (20 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf) or less
(c) Check for any cracks and grease leaks on the ball
joint dust cover.
SP–30
SUSPENSION – REAR COIL SPRING
REAR COIL SPRING
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
COIL SPRING REAR LH
15 (155, 11)
15 (155, 11)
CLIP
SP
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
98 (1,000, 72)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119735E01
SUSPENSION – REAR COIL SPRING
SP–31
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Support the rear axle housing.
(b) Remove the bolt, separate the shock absorber
assembly rear LH from the rear axle.
3.
DISCONNECT REAR BRAKE TUBE FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Using SST, disconnect the 2 rear brake tubes from
each of the flexible hoses. Use a container to catch
brake fluid as it drains out.
SST 09023-00101
(b) Remove the 2 clips and disconnect the 2 flexible
hoses.
D028132
SST
4.
D028273E02
REMOVE COIL SPRING REAR LH
(a) Start to lower the rear axle housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to snap the brake line and parking
brake cable.
(b) While lowering the rear axle housing, remove the
coil spring rear LH.
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL COIL SPRING REAR LH
(a) Install the coil spring rear LH to the rear axle
housing.
HINT:
Fit the lower end of the coil spring into the gap of the
spring lower seat
2.
CONNECT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Install the shock absorber, temporarily tighten the
bolt.
3.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (See page SP-39)
D028471
D028132
SP
SP–32
SUSPENSION – REAR COIL SPRING
4.
FULLY TIGHTEN SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
REAR LH
(a) Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 98 N*m (1,000 kgf*cm, 72 ft.*lbf)
5.
CONNECT REAR BRAKE TUBE FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Install the 2 clips with the 2 flexible hoses.
(b) Using SST, connect the break tubes to the flexible
hose.
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
SST 09023-00101
6.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
7.
BLEED BRAKE LINE
8.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
9.
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
D028132
SST
SP
D028273E03
10. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
SP–33
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
SP
CUSHION RETAINER
CUSHION NO. 1
25 (255, 18)
15 (153, 11)
SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY REAR LH
RETAINER
CUSHION
70 (714, 52)
LOWER
BRACKET
29 (296, 21)
REFERENCE TPRQUE: 25 (255, 18)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
98 (1,000, 72)
REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
C119734E01
SP–34
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
Be sure to read PRECAUTIONS before performing this
procedure (See page SC-1).
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY (See
page SP-53)
3.
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the bracket.
D028262
SP
(b) Using a wrench to hold the bracket, remove the
joint.
NOTICE:
Check that all shock absorbers are fully
extended to the normal suspension rebound
point.
D028263
D028132
(c) Remove the bolt and disconnect the shock absorber
assembly rear LH from the rear axle housing.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the rear axle housing is supported
so that the shock absorber assembly rear LH is
not extended beyond the normal suspension
rebound point.
(d) Remove the nut, cushion retainer, cushion No.1 and
shock absorber assembly rear LH.
NOTICE:
• Remove the shock absorber assembly rear
LH with the shock absorber rod fully
extended.
• Be sure to hold the body part of the shock
absorber assembly rear LH when carrying it.
(e) Remove the lower bracket from the shock absorber
assembly rear LH.
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/o REAS)
SP–37
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/o REAS)
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
SP
25 (255, 18)
CUSHION RETAINER
CUSHION NO. 1
SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY REAR LH
CUSHION NO. 2
CUSHION RETAINER
98 (1,000, 72)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119733E01
SP–38
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/o REAS)
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Support the rear axle housing.
(b) Remove the bolt and separate the shock absorber
assembly rear LH from the rear axle housing.
D028132
(c) Remove the nut, 3 cushion retainers, cushion No. 1,
cushion No. 2 and shock absorber assembly rear
LH.
SP
D028133
INSPECTION
1.
SA00627
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Compress and extend the shock absorber rod and
check that there is no abnormal resistance or
unusual sound during operation.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock
absorber with a new one.
NOTICE:
When disposing of the shock absorber, see
DISPOSAL (See page SP-39).
INSTALLATION
1.
D028133
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Install the 3 cushion retainers, cushion No. 1,
cushion No. 2 and shock absorber assembly rear
LH with the nut.
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER (w/o REAS)
SP–39
(b) Install the shock absorber assembly rear LH with
the bolt.
D028132
(c) Fully tighten the nut.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
3.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) Jack down the vehicle.
(b) Bounce the vehicle up and down several times to
stabilize the suspension.
SP
D028133
4.
FULLY TIGHTEN SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
REAR LH
(a) Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 98 N*m (1,000 kgf*cm, 72 ft.*lbf)
D028132
DISPOSAL
100 mm (3.9 in.)
55 mm (2.2 in.)
D028629E03
1.
DISPOSE OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Fully extend the shock absorber rod.
(b) Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown in
the illustration to discharge the gas inside.
CAUTION:
• When drilling, chips may fly out, and so work
carefully.
• The gas is colorless, odorless and nonpoisonous.
SP–48
SUSPENSION – REAR LOWER CONTROL ARM
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL LOWER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the lower control arm assembly, temporarily
tighten the nut, washer and bolt.
(b) Install the rear axle housing, temporarily tighten the
bolt, washer and nut.
2.
CONNECT PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO.
3
(a) Connect the parking brake cable assembly No.3
with the bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
4.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (See page SP-39)
5.
FULLY TIGHTEN LOWER CONTROL ARM
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Fully tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 130 N*m (1,326 kgf*cm, 96 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and remove the bolt.
D028142
SP
D028252
SP–54
SUSPENSION – REAR STABILIZER BAR
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR REAR
(a) Install the 2 stabilizer bushes to the stabilizer bar.
HINT:
Install the stabilizer bush to the inner side of the
stabilizer bush stopper on the stabilizer bar.
Outer Side
D028261E02
(b) Install the stabilizer bar and the 2 stabilizer brackets
with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 30 N*m (306 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
SP
D028260
2.
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the stabilizer link with the nut (LH side).
Torque: 70 N*m (714 kgf*cm, 52 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
(b) Install the 2 retainers and the cushion to the
stabilizer link.
D028258
(c) Hold the stabilizer bar link with a wrench, and install
the nut, retainer, cushion and link.
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
D028259
3.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Install the RH side by following the same procedures
with the LH side.
4.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
SP–40
SUSPENSION – REAR PNEUMATIC CYLINDER
REAR PNEUMATIC CYLINDER
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
AIR TUBE
CLIP
PNEUMATIC CYLINDER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
SP
C119736E01
SUSPENSION – REAR PNEUMATIC CYLINDER
SP–41
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE PNEUMATIC CYLINDER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Jack up vehicle and support the frame with safety
stands.
NOTICE:
• Do the work with the rear axle assembly
lowered.
• Do the work with the shock absorber
installed.
(b) Disconnect the height control tube (See page SC1).
(c) Remove the clip on the upper side of the pneumatic
cylinder (See page SC-1).
HINT:
If the clip cannot easily be removed, thread a wire
through the hole to pull it.
(d) Discharge air from the pneumatic cylinder assembly
to retract it.
D028275
(e) Turn the pneumatic cylinder assembly 90 degrees
and remove it from the rear axle assembly.
NOTICE:
Do not extend the pneumatic cylinder assembly.
HINT:
If the pneumatic cylinder assembly is to be reused,
2 new o-rings as well as a new plate and height
control plug must be used (See page SC-1).
Rear Axle
Assembly
D028279E01
INSTALLATION
1.
Clip
D028276E01
INSTALL PNEUMATIC CYLINDER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Install the pneumatic cylinder assembly with the
clip.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the clip is secured tightly onto
the cylinder.
(b) Connect the height control tube (See page SC-1).
SP
SP–42
SUSPENSION – REAR PNEUMATIC CYLINDER
(c) When using safety stands and jack:
(1) Jack up the rear axle assembly until the bottom
of the pneumatic cylinder assembly touches the
rear axle assembly and install the clip at the
lower side of the pneumatic cylinder assembly
into the keyhole in the rear axle assembly.
NOTICE:
• Do not extend the pneumatic cylinder
assembly for clip installation.
• Make sure that the clip at the lower side
of the pneumatic cylinder assembly fits
in the keyhole in the rear axle assembly.
(2) Remove the safety stands with care not to
extend the pneumatic cylinder assembly when
jacking down the vehicle till it sits on the
ground.
NOTICE:
• Do not extend the pneumatic cylinder
assembly by lowering the rear axle
assembly with safety stands installed.
• Make sure that the diaphragm of the
pneumatic cylinder assembly is not
deformed.
(d) When using a swing arm type lift:
(1) Lower the vehicle till the tires hit the ground,
and continue lowering slowly until the bottom of
the pneumatic cylinder assembly touches the
rear axle assembly.
(2) Align the seating pin on the cylinder with the
keyhole in the rear axle assembly and install
the pneumatic cylinder assembly on the rear
axle assembly.
(3) Lower the lift carefully so as not to extend the
pneumatic cylinder assembly.
NOTICE:
• Do not extend the pneumatic cylinder
assembly by lifting up the rear axle
housing after installing the clip.
• Make sure that the diaphragm of the
pneumatic cylinder assembly is not
deformed.
(e) Start the engine and replenish the pneumatic
cylinder assembly with air.
Do not extend the
pneumatic cylinder
assembly
Seating Pin
Keyhole
SP
G026946E01
2.
INSPECT AIR LEAK
HINT:
(See page SC-3)
3.
INSPECT VEHICLE HEIGHT
HINT:
(See page SC-3)
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
SP–57
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the center control absorber assembly with the
3 nuts.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
D028265
(b) Install the bracket with the bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
SP
D028264
(c) Using a spanner to hold the bracket, install the joint.
D028263
(d) Refer to HINT below.
HINT:
Tighten the joint so that the gap spacing becomes 1
mm (0.04 in.).
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
1 mm (0.04 in.)
D028267E01
(e) Using a spanner to hold the center control absorber
assembly, install the joint.
D028266
SP–58
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
(f)
1 mm (0.04 in.)
Refer to HINT below.
HINT:
Tighten the joint so that the gap spacing becomes 1
mm (0.04 in.).
Torque: Reference
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page SP-54)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSPECT FLUID LEAK
HINT:
(See page SC-3)
D028267E01
DISPOSAL
1.
SP
D028472
DISPOSE OF CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown in
the illustration to discharge the gas inside.
(b) Remove the flare nut.
(c) Drain absorber oil.
SUSPENSION – REAR UPPER CONTROL ARM
SP–43
REAR UPPER CONTROL ARM
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
SP
80 (816, 59)
WITH AIR SUSPENSION:
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
80 (816, 59)
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR LINK
UPPER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119737E01
SP–44
SUSPENSION – REAR UPPER CONTROL ARM
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
DISCONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR LINK
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR (w/ Air Suspension)
HINT:
(See page SC-94)
3.
REMOVE UPPER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut, washer and bolt from rear axle
housing.
HINT:
While fixing the bolt, turn and remove the nut.
D028137
(b) Remove the nut, washer and bolt with the upper
control arm assembly.
HINT:
While fixing the bolt, turn and remove the nut.
SP
D028138
INSTALLATION
1.
With Air Suspension:
Front
Outer Side
D028458E01
INSTALL UPPER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the upper control arm assembly, temporarily
tighten the nut, washer and bolt.
HINT:
In the case of the air suspensions, install them by
referring to the illustration.
SUSPENSION – REAR UPPER CONTROL ARM
SP–45
(b) Install the rear axle housing, temporarily tighten the
nut, washer and bolt.
2.
CONNECT HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR LINK SUBASSEMBLY REAR (w/ Air Suspension)
HINT:
(See page SC-95)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
4.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (See page SP-39)
5.
FULLY TIGHTEN UPPER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY
(a) Fully tighten the 2 nuts.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
While fixing the bolt, turn and install the nut.
D028137
SP
D028140
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE (w/ REAS)
SP–61
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
Be sure to read PRECAUTIONS before performing this
procedure (See page SC-1).
1.
REMOVE TUBE PROTECTOR LH
(a) Remove the bolt and the tube protector LH.
2.
REMOVE CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE LH
(a) Using a spanner to hold the center control absorber
assembly LH, disconnect the joint.
NOTICE:
Check that all four shock absorbers are fully
extended to the normal suspension rebound
point.
D028462
D028266
(b) Using a spanner to hold the bracket, remove the
joint.
D028268
(c) Using a pliers, cut the center control absorber tube.
Use a container to catch absorber as it drains out.
(d) Remove the center control absorber tubes from the
frame.
D028470
SP
SP–62
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE (w/ REAS)
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE LH
(a) Install the center control absorber tube (Rear side)
with the bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
D028474
(b) Using a spanner to hold the counter control
absorber assembly, install the joint.
SP
D028266
(c) Refer to HINT below.
HINT:
Tighten the joint so that the gap spacing becomes 1
mm (0.04 in.)
Torque: Reference
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
1 mm (0.04 in.)
D028267E01
(d) Pass through the center control absorber tube
(Front side) between the body and the frame.
D028476
(e) Pass the opposite side of the center control
absorber tube over the frame.
NOTICE:
Do not bend the center control tube excessively.
D028475
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE (w/ REAS)
(f)
SP–63
Using a spanner to hold the bracket, install the joint.
D028473
(g) Refer to HINT below.
HINT:
Tighten the joint so that the gap spacing becomes 1
mm (0.04 in.)
Torque: Reference
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
1 mm (0.04 in.)
SP
D028267E01
(h) Using a spanner to hold the bracket, install the joint.
D028268
(i)
1 mm (0.04 in.)
Refer to HINT below.
HINT:
Tighten the joint so that the gap spacing becomes 1
mm (0.04 in.)
Torque: Reference
25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
D028267E01
D028462
2.
INSTALL TUBE PROTECTOR LH
(a) Install the tube protector LH with the bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSPECT FLUID LEAK
HINT:
(See page SC-3)
SP–46
SUSPENSION – REAR LOWER CONTROL ARM
REAR LOWER CONTROL ARM
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
SP
130 (1,326, 96)
13 (127, 9)
130 (1,326, 96)
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 3
LOWER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119738E02
SUSPENSION – REAR LOWER CONTROL ARM
SP–47
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
NO. 3
(a) Remove the bolt, separate the parking brake cable
assembly No.3.
3.
REMOVE LOWER CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the nut, washer and bolt from rear axle
housing.
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and remove the bolt.
D028142
(b) Remove the nut, washer, bolt and the lower control
arm assembly.
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and remove the bolt.
D028250
SP
SP–49
SUSPENSION – REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
130 (1,326, 96)
REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD ASSEMBLY
SP
130 (1,326, 96)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119739E01
SP–50
SUSPENSION – REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt.
D028254
(b) Remove the bolt, nut and lateral control rod
assembly.
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and remove the bolt.
SP
D028255
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the lateral control rod assembly with the bolt.
D028254
(b) Install the bolt and the nut.
2.
D028255
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (See page SP-39)
SUSPENSION – REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
3.
D028256
SP–51
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR LATERAL CONTROL ROD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Fully tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 130 N*m (1,326 kgf*cm, 96 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and install the bolt.
SP
SP–52
SUSPENSION – REAR STABILIZER BAR
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
15 (153, 11)
RETAINER
CUSHION
SP
70 (714, 52)
STABILIZER BAR REAR
STABILIZER BUSH
70 (714, 52)
STABILIZER
BRACKET
15 (153, 11)
RETAINER
CUSHION
STABILIZER BUSH
30 (306, 22)
STABILIZER BRACKET
RETAINER
30 (306, 22)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
CUSHION
REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
C119740E01
SUSPENSION – REAR STABILIZER BAR
SP–53
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer bar
from the stabilizer link (LH side).
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a
hexagon wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
D028258
(b) Hold the stabilizer bar link with a wrench and
remove the nut, retainer, cushion and link.
(c) Remove the 2 retainers and cushion from the
stabilizer link.
3.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Remove the RH side by following the same procedures
with the LH side.
D028259
4.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR REAR
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, the 2 stabilizer brackets and
the stabilizer bar.
(b) Remove the 2 stabilizer bushes from the stabilizer
bar.
D028260
INSPECTION
1.
D028478
INSPECT REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud
back and forth 5 times before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 2 - 4 seconds per 1 turn, and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Torque: 0.05 - 2.0 N*m (0.5 -20 kgf*cm, 0.4 - 17.7
in.*lbf)
SP
SP–55
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
15 (153, 11)
RETAINER
CUSHION
SP
70 (714, 52)
29 (296, 21)
REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
29 (296, 21)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119741E01
SP–56
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER (w/ REAS)
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
Be sure to read PRECAUTIONS before performing this
procedure (See page SC-1).
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page SP-53)
3.
REMOVE CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a spanner to hold the bracket, remove the
joint.
NOTICE:
Check that all four shock absorbers are fully
extended to the normal suspension rebound
point.
D028263
SP
(b) Remove the bolt and disconnect the bracket.
D028264
(c) Using a spanner to hold the center control absorber
assembly, remove the joint.
NOTICE:
• Do not loosen the flare nut.
• Do not deform or damage the tubes.
D028266
(d) Remove the 3 nuts and the center control absorber
assembly.
NOTICE:
• Do not deform or damage the tubes.
• Be sure to hold the body part to carry the
center control absorber assembly.
D028265
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE (w/ REAS)
SP–59
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE (w/ REAS)
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE RH
REFERENCE
REFERENCE TORQUE:
TORQUE: 25
25 (255,
(255, 18)
18)
TUBE PROTECTOR RH
29 (296, 21)
REFERENCE
REFERENCE TORQUE:
TORQUE: 25
25 (255,
(255, 18)
18)
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE LH
29 (296, 21)
TUBE PROTECTOR LH
REFERENCE
REFERENCE TORQUE:
TORQUE: 25
25 (255,
(255, 18)
18)
REFERENCE
REFERENCE TORQUE:
TORQUE: 25
25 (255,
(255, 18)
18)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119742E01
SP
SP–60
SUSPENSION – CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE (w/ REAS)
SUPPLIED PARTS:
CENTER CONTROL
ABSORBER TUBE
RH (REAR SIDE)
CENTER CONTROL
ABSORBER TUBE
RH (FRONT SIDE)
29 (296, 21)
SP
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
29 (296, 21)
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE LH (REAR SIDE)
REFERENCE TORQUE: 25 (255, 18)
CENTER CONTROL ABSORBER TUBE LH (FRONT SIDE)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119743E01
TW–6
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE
AND TRANSMITTER (for Spare)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND
TRANSMITTER (for Rear RH)
TW
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND
TRANSMITTER (for Front RH)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE
AND TRANSMITTER (for Rear LH)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND
TRANSMITTER (for Front LH)
C131565E03
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–7
COMBINATION METER
- TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
GAUGE FUSE
TW
ECU-IG FUSE
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
C131373E03
TW–8
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
- Vehicle Speed
Tire Pressure Warning
Antenna and Receiver
Tire
Pressure
Warning
ECU
Combination Meter
- Tire Pressure Warning Light
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(for Front LH)
TW
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(for Front RH)
DLC3
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(for Rear LH)
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(for Rear RH)
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(for Spare)
: Radio Signal
C141685E03
HINT:
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter sends
information on the temperature inside the tire, the ID, and the
tire pressure.
TW–9
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
DESCRIPTION OF SYSTEM
(a) Each tire pressure warning valve and transmitter is
equipped with a tire pressure sensor and a
transmitter and is installed in each tire wheel
assembly. The sensor measures the tire pressure.
The measured value and transmitter ID are
transmitted to the tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver on the body as radio waves and then
sent to the tire pressure warning ECU from the tire
pressure warning antenna and receiver. If the
transmitter ID has already been registered, the ECU
compares the measured air pressure value with the
standard value. When the value is less than the
standard value registered in the tire pressure
warning ECU, the warning light on the combination
meter comes on.
Combination Meter
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
- Tire Pressure Warning Light
TW
Front
Tire Pressure Warning
Antenna and Receiver
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and Transmitter
C150461E01
2.
Normal
on
3 seconds
off
Defect
on
off
INITIAL CHECK
(a) The tire pressure warning light turns on for 3
seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON, and
then goes off.
HINT:
If the warning light does not turn on for 3 seconds,
troubleshoot the pressure warning light circuit.
Trouble Area
Tire pressure warning light circuit
Ignition Switch ON
C124985E03
Proceed to
TW-58
TW–10
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
3.
TW
4.
Components
WHEN TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT IS LIT
(a) When the tire pressure warning light does not go off,
or when it comes on during driving, check the tire
pressure. If the tire pressure warning light comes on
within several hours after adjusting the tire
pressure, the tire may have a slow air leak.
(b) Under the following conditions, the system may not
function properly.
• Facilities or devices that use similar radio
frequencies are located in the vicinity of the
vehicle.
• A radio device of similar frequency is used in the
vehicle.
• A large amount of snow or ice is stuck to the
vehicle, especially onto the wheels and around
the wheel houses.
• The battery of the sensor has been depleted.
• Tires without a tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter are used.
• Tire chains are used.
• When the full-size spare tire is not within the
receivable range of the electric wave, a signal
may not be received because the spare tire is
fixed. Accordingly, the system may not function
properly. If there is a possibility that the tire
pressure warning system does not receive a
signal from the spare tire, rotate the tire 90°.
• If any wheels other than the specified ones are
used, the system may not function properly
because interference may prevent the radio
waves from being correctly transmitted from the
tire pressure sensor.
• Depending on the tire type, the system may not
function properly even though the specified
wheels are used.
(c) The average usage life of the grommet of the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter is
approximately 5 years, at which time it must be
replaced.
If air is leaking from the tire but the tire is less than 5
years old and there is no problem with grommets,
retighten the valve nut.
(d) After removing and installing the ECU or a sensor,
check for a diagnostic trouble code and verify that it
is a normal code.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
Function
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Combined as a single unit with a disc wheel air valve, it measures tire pressure and
temperature and transmits an ID number for measurement value and identification.
Has a built-in battery.
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Receives and transmits a necessary signal from the transmitter to the tire pressure
warning ECU.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Receives the signal from the receiver and identifies it as vehicle's own signal. If the
measured value is equal to or lower than the specified value, it transmits a signal so
that the tire pressure warning light on the combination meter comes on.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Components
Tire pressure warning light
TW–11
Function
Located in the combination meter, it informs the driver of lowered tire air pressure
and system failure.
TW
TW–12
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the tire pressure
warning system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Interview the customer to confirm the trouble.
HINT:
It is important to collect as much specific information as
possible from the customer to allow for a quick repair.
TW
NEXT
3
ADJUST TIRE PRESSURE*
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and the tester ON.
Following the display on the intelligent tester, read
"DATA LIST" (see page TW-25).
(e) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
(f) Adjust all tire pressures to the standard values (see page
TW-1).
(g) Check the DATA LIST (see page TW-25).
HINT:
• It takes about 2 or 3 minutes to display the updated
tire pressure data.
• If the problem is that the tire pressure decreases, wait
until all of the tire pressure data is received by the
ECU. If the data is received, the tire pressure warning
light will turn off.
Result
Condition
A
Tire pressure warning light remains on.
B
A
B
Proceed to
Tire pressure warning light goes off.
Go to step 9
TW–13
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTC (see page TW-23).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
Go to step 6
A
5
DTC CHART
(a) Refer to DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (see
page TW-27).
NEXT
TW
Go to step 8
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Refer to PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (see page TW19).
NEXT
7
CIRCUIT INSPECTION*
(a) Refer to ELECTRONIC CIRCUIT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE (see page IN-38).
NEXT
8
REPAIR OR REPLACE
(a) Repair or replace parts based on the diagnosis result.
NEXT
9
CONFIRMATION TEST*
(a) Check the DATA LIST to confirm that the tire inflation
pressure has been received (see page TW-25).
TW–14
NEXT
END
TW
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–50
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2165/65 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID1 Tire
DTC
C2166/66 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID2 Tire
DTC
C2167/67 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID3 Tire
DTC
C2168/68 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID4 Tire
DTC
C2169/69 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID5 Tire
DESCRIPTION
Each tire pressure warning valve and transmitter measures the internal temperature of its tire as well as
tire pressure, and transmits the information to the tire pressure warning ECU along with the transmitter ID.
If the measured temperature is out of the specified range, the tire pressure warning ECU recognizes it as
a malfunction, outputs DTCs, and blinks the tire pressure warning light.
DTC Code
C2165/65
C2166/66
C2167/67
C2168/68
C2169/69
TW
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Temperature inside the tire exceeds 119°C (246.2°F)
more than once.
•
•
•
Tires
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is
malfunctioning because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and note them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU and/or valve and transmitter has been replaced.
1
CHECK TIRES
(a) Check that the tires are not flat, and have no indication of
air pressure drop.
OK:
Tires are normal.
HINT:
If a tire is damaged, the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter may also have been damaged at the same
time.
NG
OK
REPLACE TIRE AND TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW–51
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
2
IDENTIFY TRANSMITTER CORRESPONDING TO DTC
(a) Set the tire pressure to the specified value (see page
TW-1).
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(e) Display the "TIREPRESS" data for each wheel using the
intelligent tester.
(f) Rapidly reduce the tire pressure for each wheel at least
40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) within 30 seconds.
(g) Check the DATA LIST.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS1
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation
pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for relative
pressure, data has not been received.*
kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
TW
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS2
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation
pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for relative
pressure, data has not been received.*
kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS3
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation
pressure
2
kgf/cm , 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for relative
pressure, data has not been received.*
kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS4
cm2
, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation
pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for relative
pressure, data has not been received.*
kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS5
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5
Actual tire inflation
pressure
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for relative
pressure, data has not been received.*
kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed. If the values are not displayed after a few
minutes, perform troubleshooting according to the
inspection procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25
(see page TW-34).
TW–52
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Result
Condition
Detection Condition
One of "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5) changed.
Normal
No "TIREPRESS" data changed.
TW
Transmitter corresponding to DTC
NOTICE:
• It takes about 2 or 3 minutes to display the updated
tire pressure data.
• When no "TIREPRESS" data has changed, reset the
tire pressure to the appropriate specified value and
rotate the tire 90 to 270°. Then forcibly transmit the
transmitter ID and recheck it.
• Record the transmitter ID and position of transmitters
that are normal.
(h) When the "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5) has changed,
repeat this procedure to identify the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter that corresponds to a
DTC.
(i) When all of the "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5) has
changed, identify the malfunctioning tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter based on the recorded ID
numbers and output DTC.
NEXT
3
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
(a) Replace the identified tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter with a new one (see page TW-73).
HINT:
• Before installing a new tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter, read and write down its transmitter ID.
• The IDs for the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitters that are not replaced should be checked using
tester and recorded.
NEXT
4
CHECK REGISTRATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Register the transmitter ID for all wheels (see page TW13).
(b) Set the tire pressure of all wheels to the specified value.
NEXT
5
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
TW–53
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(d) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS1
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS2
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS3
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS4
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/
TIREPRESS5
cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed. If the values are not displayed after a few
minutes, perform troubleshooting according to the
inspection procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25
(see page TW-34).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
All tire pressure readings are equal to specified values.
A
Tire pressure values are not displayed.
B
B
A
END
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(See page TW-78)
TW
TW–54
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2171/71 Transmitter ID not Registered
DESCRIPTION
The IDs of each tire pressure warning valve and transmitter are registered to the tire pressure warning
ECU.
When the ECU detects that an ID is not one of the registered IDs, or cannot receive an ID signal, a DTC is
output.
DTC Code
C2171/71
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Transmitter ID code is not registered. (When an ID code is
unregistered for 51 minutes or more)
Tire pressure warning ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and note them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU has been replaced.
TW
1
CONFIRM REGISTRATION CONDITION (REGISTERED ID CODES)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester on.
Select "REGIT ID CODE" by following the prompts
displayed on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID1 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID2 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID3 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID4 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID5 CODE
Registered ID5 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID5 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
OK:
The registered transmitter ID codes are displayed
on the intelligent tester screen.
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(See page TW-78)
NG
2
PERFORM REGISTRATION (TRANSMITTER ID)
(a) Register the transmitter IDs for all the wheels (see page
TW-13).
TW–55
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
NEXT
3
READ VALUE ON DATA LIST
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Check the DATA LIST.
Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or -
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS1
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Diagnostic Note
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure, data
has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or -
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS2
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure, data
has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or -
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS3
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure, data
has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or -
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS4
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure, data
has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or -
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS5
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
Actual tire inflation pressure
100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure, data
has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
All tire pressure readings are equal to specified values.
A
Tire pressure values not display
B
TW
TW–56
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
B
A
END
TW
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(See page TW-78)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
TW–1
TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
IN CASE OF REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF TIRE
PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
(a) When installing a tire, make sure that the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter does not
interfere with the tire bead so that damage to the
sensor is prevented.
(b) After completing the operation, remove the valve
core to rapidly release air and check that the
warning light is lit. If not, the system may be
defective.
(c) If there is air leakage, tighten the nut with a force of
4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) and push the valve
core 2 or 3 times to remove any dirt attached on the
valve core. If there is still air leakage, replace the
grommet, the washer and the nut all together.
(d) When installing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter, check whether the rim, grommet,
washer and nut are clean. Use a manufacturerspecified cap.
(e) When putting air into the tire, first install the tire
pressure valve straight onto the stem of the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter.
IN CASE OF TIRE AND WHEEL REPLACEMENT OR
TIRE ROTATION
(a) When replacing tires, be sure to check if the
grommet of the tire valve is damaged or not. If so,
replace the grommet together with the washer and
nut.
(b) When tires and wheels are replaced, register the
transmitter ID without fail.
TW
TW–2
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT TIRE
(a) Check the tires for wear and proper inflation
pressure.
Cold tire inflation pressure:
Except MEXICO
Tire size
Pressure
P265/60R18 109H
P265/65R17 110S
P265/70R16 111S
220 kPa (2.2 kgf/cm2, 32 psi)
MEXICO
Tire size
Pressure
P265/65R17 112S
P265/70R16 111S
200 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 29 psi)
(b) Using a dial indicator, check the tire runout.
Tire runout:
3.0 mm (0.118 in.) or less
TW
R003031
2.
ROTATE TIRE
(a) Rotate tires as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
See the illustration for where to rotate each tire
when you include the spare tire in rotation.
3.
INSPECT WHEEL BALANCE
(a) Check and adjust the Off-the-car balance.
(b) If necessary, check and adjust the On-the-car
balance.
Imbalance after adjustment:
265/70R16:
8 g (0.018 lb) or less
265/65R17:
7 g (0.015 lb) or less
4.
INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB (See page AH-1)
5.
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB (See page AH-1)
Front
G022181E01
C080976
TW–57
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2176/76 Receiver Error
DESCRIPTION
The signals are transmitted to the tire pressure warning antenna and receiver on the body as radio waves
and then sent to the tire pressure warning ECU.
DTC Code
Detection Condition
C2176/76
DTC is stored when any of the following is detected:
• Malfunction in the tire pressure warning ECU internal
circuit.
• Terminal RF5V is shorted to ground.
• Malfunction in the tire pressure warning antenna and
receiver internal circuit.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
+5V
5
8
RF5V
TW
RDA
GND
1
7
4
16
T17
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
RDA
GND2
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
E133110E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and write them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU has been replaced.
TW–58
1
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECU - RECEIVER)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
7 (RDA)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver)
T16
T17
8 (RF5V)
5 (+5V)
1 (RDA)
16 (GND2)
4 (GND)
C150484E01
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the T17 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
TW
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T16-7 (RDA) - T17-1 (RDA)
Always
Below 1 Ω
T16-8 (RF5V) - T17-5 (+5V)
Always
Below 1 Ω
T16-16 (GND2) - T17-4 (GND)
Always
Below 1 Ω
T16-7 (RDA) or T17-1 (RDA) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
T16-8 (RF5V) or T17-5 (+5V) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
T16-16 (GND2) or T17-4 (GND) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
OK
Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TW–59
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
2
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
Component with harness connected:
(Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
T16-8 (RF5V) - T16-16 (GND2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
NG
8 (RF5V)
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(See page TW-78)
T16
16 (GND2)
C150486E01
OK
TW
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA AND RECEIVER (See page TW-70)
TW–60
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2191/91 Vehicle Speed Signal Error (Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning ECU receives a speed signal from the combination meter. This DTC is stored
upon entering test mode, and cleared when a vehicle speed signal of 20 km/h (12 mph) is detected for 3
seconds or more. This DTC is output only in test mode.
DTC Code
C2191/91
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Speed sensor circuit malfunction
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
TW
5
3
SPD
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
C9
Combination Meter
E115290E45
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and write them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU have been replaced.
1
READ VALUE ON INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON, and turn the intelligent tester
on.
TW–61
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(d) Select the item below in the Data List, and read the value
displayed on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
VEHICLE SPD
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Vehicle speed/ min.: 0 km/h (0 mph),
max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Diagnostic Note
Almost same as actual vehicle
speed
-
(e) Check that the values indicated on the tester and on the
combination meter are the same.
OK:
The vehicle speed displayed on the tester changes
depending on the actual vehicle speed.
NG
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM (See page
ME-4)
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECU - COMBINATION METER)
T16
TW
Front view of wire harness connector:
(to Combination Meter)
Front view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
C9
111213 141516171819 20
SPD
C150489E01
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the C9 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T16-3 (SPD) - C9-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
T16-3 (SPD) or C9-5 - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU (See page TW-78)
TW–62
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tire Pressure Warning Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, the tire pressure warning light blinks and the tire pressure monitor is canceled
at the same time. At this time, the ECU records a DTC in the memory.
Connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 makes the tire pressure warning light blink and output the
DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
6
IND
TW
C8
Combination Meter
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
E115290E47
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU has been replaced.
TW–63
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING ECU)
Front view of wire harness connector:
(to Combination Meter)
Front view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
T16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
C8
111213 141516171819 20
IND
C150489E02
(a) Disconnect the C8 combination meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the T16 tire pressure warning ECU
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T16-6 (IND) - C8-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
T16-6 (IND) or C8-1 - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TW
TW–64
2
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK COMBINATION METER
Component without harness connected:
(Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the tire pressure warning
ECU.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check the condition of
the tire pressure warning light illumination.
Result
Condition
Illuminates
A
Does not illuminate
B
B
T16
Proceed to
REPLACE COMBINATION METER (See page
ME-59)
C150492E01
A
TW
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU (See page TW-78)
TW–65
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the tire pressure warning ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
2
from Ignition Switch
IG
ECU-IG
11
GND
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
C150493E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-13).
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the instrument panel
junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
ECU-IG fuse
NG
OK
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
Go to step 4
TW
TW–66
2
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
T16-2 (IG) - Body ground
NG
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
T16
2 (IG)
C150492E04
OK
TW
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECU - BODY GROUND)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
T16-11 (GND) - Body ground
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
T16
11 (GND)
C150492E03
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU (See page TW-78)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
4
TW–67
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECU - BODY GROUND)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
T16-2 (IG) - Body ground
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE FUSE AND REPAIR OR REPLACE
HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
T16
2 (IG)
C150492E04
OK
TW
REPLACE FUSE
TW–68
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
DTC output mode is set by connecting terminals 13 (TC) and 4 (CG) of the DLC3. The DTCs are indicated
by the blinking of the tire pressure warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TC
CG
12
13
TC
4
D1
DLC3
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
TW
C150494E01
HINT:
When each warning light blinks continuously, a ground short in the wiring of terminal TC of the DLC3 or an
internal ground short in an ECU connected to this circuit may have occurred.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-13).
TW–69
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU)
DLC3
CG
D1
TC
Front view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
T16
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T16-12 (TC) - D1-13 (TC)
Always
Below 1 Ω
T16-12 (TC) or D1-13 (TC) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
TW
TC
C150495E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
TW–71
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
(a) Disconnect the negative terminal.
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT (for 50/50 Split Seat
Type) (See page SE-36)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (for 60/
40 Split Seat Type LH Side) (See page SE-41)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (for 60/
40 Split Seat Type RH Side) (See page SE-49)
5.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the roof
headlining assembly (See page IR-7).
6.
REMOVE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA
AND RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and receiver assembly.
TW
F046094
INSTALLATION
F046094
1.
INSTALL TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA
AND RECEIVER
(a) Install the receiver assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 6.8 N*m (69 kgf*cm, 60 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT (for 50/50 Split Seat
Type) (See page SE-38)
4.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (for 60/40
Split Seat Type LH Side) (See page SE-46)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (for 60/40
Split Seat Type RH Side) (See page SE-53)
6.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
7.
REGISTRATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
HINT:
(See page TW-13)
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
TW–78
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
(a) Disconnect the negative terminal.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-9)
3.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page IP9)
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2 (See page IP-9)
5.
REMOVE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and tire pressure warning
ECU.
F046450
TW
INSTALLATION
F046450
1.
INSTALL TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(a) Install the tire pressure warning ECU with the 2
screws.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
3.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
4.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
5.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
6.
REGISTRATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
HINT:
(See page TW-13)
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–15
REGISTRATION
1.
DESCRIPTION OF CODE REGISTRATION
It is necessary to register the transmitter ID in the tire
pressure warning ECU when replacing the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter and/or tire pressure
warning ECU.
Prepare all transmitter ID data before starting
registration.
(a) Before registration
(1) In case of tire pressure warning ECU
replacement.
• Read the registered transmitter IDs that are
stored in the old ECU using the intelligent
tester and note them down.
• If reading stored transmitter IDs is
impossible due to malfunctions of
components such as the tire pressure
warning antenna and receiver, remove the
tires from the wheels and check the IDs
located on the tire pressure warning valves
and transmitters (see page TW-3).
(2) In case of tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter replacement.
• Take a note of the 7 digit number
(transmitter ID) written on the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter.
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and Transmitter:
Transmitter ID
(7 Digit Number)
E128762E10
NOTICE:
The transmitter ID is written on the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter.
It will be unable to be read after installing
the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter on the tire and wheel.
Therefore, take a note of the transmitter
ID before installing the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter.
TW
TW–16
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
2.
REGISTER TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Set the air pressure of all wheels to the specified
value (see page TW-1).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3
(Procedure "A").
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON (Procedure "B").
(d) Select the REGIST TIRE following the intelligent
tester screen (UTILITY - REGIST TIRE) (Procedure
"C").
DLC3
Intelligent Tester
C150424E01
(e) Input the IDs (ID1 to ID5) using the intelligent tester
and transmit them to the tire pressure warning ECU
(Procedure "D").
TW
F100622
(f)
C107265
Set the ID transmission condition to "ID Registration
is complete" (Procedure "E").
HINT:
• The previously registered IDs will be deleted
from the memory when the registration is
completed.
• If the procedures "C" to "D" are not completed
within 5 minutes, the mode will return to normal
operation mode.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–17
Registration Procedure
TW
C153431E01
3.
CONFIRMATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
REGISTRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 (ignition
switch is OFF).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts
displayed on the intelligent tester.
TW–18
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(d) Confirm that the data of tire pressure of all tires
(including the spare tire) are displayed on the
intelligent tester screen.
NOTICE:
• It may take up to about 2 or 3 minutes to
update the tire pressure data. If the values are
not displayed after a few minutes, perform
troubleshooting according to the inspection
procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25
(see page TW-34)
• DTC C2171/71 is set in the tire pressure
warning ECU if all of the following occur: 1)
the IDs have not been registered for 51
minutes or more; 2) vehicle speed of 8 km/h
(5 mph) or more is detected; and 3) no signals
are received for another 12 minutes or more.
• If normal pressure values are displayed, the
IDs have been registered correctly.
• If the tire pressure values are not displayed
after a few minutes, the IDs may be incorrect
or the system may have a malfunction.
TEST MODE PROCEDURE
TW
1.
DLC3
Intelligent Tester
C150424E01
ENTER TEST MODE
(a) Make sure that the ignition switch is OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Check that the tire pressure warning light comes on
for 3 seconds and then goes off.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–19
(e) Select the TEST MODE on the intelligent tester.
C122887
(f)
2.
0.125 sec.
ON
OFF
0.125 sec.
F100632E04
Confirm that the tire pressure warning light in the
combination meter blinks at 0.125 second intervals.
PERFORM SIGNAL CHECK
HINT:
• When entering signal check mode, the tire pressure
warning ECU sets all the signal check DTCs first.
After completing the signal check for each inspection
item, the DTCs for systems that are determined to be
normal by the tire pressure warning ECU will be
erased.
The DTCs for other inspection items may not be
erased when only a certain signal is inspected.
• When signal check returns to normal mode, all the
signal check DTCs will be erased.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
DLC3
Intelligent Tester
C150424E01
Make sure that the ignition switch is OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Select the SIGNAL CHECK on the intelligent tester.
HINT:
Every time the test mode DTC erasure conditions
are satisfied, the tire pressure warning light comes
on for 1 second. Then, the tire pressure warning
light blinks at 0.125 second intervals.
TW
TW–20
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW
C110644
(e) Drive the vehicle at 20 km/h (12 mph) or more for 10
seconds or more to check the vehicle speed signal
(C2191/91).
(f) Loosen the valve core and rapidly reduce the
pressure (at least 40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi)
within 30 seconds or more) to check the transmitter
data (C2181/81 to C2185/85).
HINT:
The transmitter ID can be transmitted by rapidly
reducing the tire pressure.
(g) Check that the tire pressure warning system test
mode DTCs are erased.
Test Mode DTC
Test Signal
Test Mode DTC Clear Condition
C2181/81 to C2185/85
Transmitter Data
Receive data from the transmitter which has a registered ID in
the tire pressure warning ECU
C2191/91
Vehicle Speed Signal
Vehicle speed of 20 km/h (12 mph) or more is detected for 3
seconds or more
(h) Result
HINT:
After the signal check is completed, check for a
signal check DTC to confirm the system status.
Condition
Procedure
Test mode DTC is output
Repair the faulty part and enter SIGNAL CHECK again
Test mode DTCs are cleared
No problem
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(i)
(j)
DTC No.
TW–21
End of SIGNAL CHECK
After completing the test mode (SIGNAL CHECK),
turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the
tester.
DTC of SIGNAL CHECK (TEST DIAGNOSIS)
If a trouble code is displayed during the test mode
DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code. For
details of each code, refer to the "See page" below.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C2181/81
Transmitter ID1 not received
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2182/82
Transmitter ID2 not received
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2183/83
Transmitter ID3 not received
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2184/84
Transmitter ID4 not received
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2185/85
Transmitter ID5 not received
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2191/91
Vehicle speed signal error
•
•
•
•
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter assembly
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-56
TW
TW–3
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
Tire Pressure Warning Light
C150462E01
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM PRECAUTION
(a) When the tire pressure warning light comes on,
immediately check the tire pressure of the tire and
adjust it to the specified value. (The tire pressure
warning light will blink if there is an open in the tire
pressure warning light circuit.)
NOTICE:
Check the spare tire as well since this system
monitors pressure of all tires including the
spare tire.
Standard cold tire inflation pressure
Tire size
Pressure
P265/60R18 109H
P265/65R17 110S
220 kPa (2.2 kgf/cm2, 32 psi)
P265/70R16 111S
(b) When the tire pressure warning light blinks, there is
a malfunction in the system. Check for DTCs.
(c) It is necessary to register the transmitter ID in the
tire pressure warning ECU after replacing the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter and/or tire
pressure warning ECU (see page TW-13).
(d) When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU:
(1) Using the DATA LIST, read the transmitter IDs
registered in the ECU and make a note of them
before removing the tire pressure warning ECU.
(2) Register the transmitter IDs after installing a new
tire pressure warning ECU.
TW
TW–4
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(e) When replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter:
(1) Take a note of the 7 digit number (transmitter ID)
written on the new tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter when replacing it. Register the
transmitter IDs in the tire pressure warning ECU
after replacing the tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter and installing the tires and
wheels on the vehicle.
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and Transmitter:
Transmitter ID
(7 Digit Number)
TW
E128762E10
2.
3.
NOTICE:
The transmitter ID is written on the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter. It
will be unable to be read after installing the
tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
on the tire and wheel. Therefore, take a note
of the transmitter ID before installing the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter.
(f) Precautions about the tire pressure:
• The tire pressures decrease naturally.
• In winter, tire pressure may decrease due to low
ambient temperatures (tire pressure decreases
by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 kgf/cm2, 1.45 psi)
for every 10°C (50°F) drop in the ambient
temperature). Therefore, the tire pressure
warning is more likely to operate if the tire
pressures are not adjusted appropriately. If the
daily temperature variation is large, pressurize
the tires high so that the tire pressures are
suitable under cold conditions. Incorrect tire
pressure warning operation becomes less likely.
IN CASE OF TIRE AND WHEEL REPLACEMENT
(a) When tires and wheels are replaced, always ensure
that each transmitter ID is correctly registered.
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) When a system malfunction occurs in the tire
pressure warning system, the tire pressure warning
light blinks and informs the driver of the system
failure.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
4.
TW–5
(b) The result of this diagnosis is stored in the tire
pressure warning ECU.
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE AFTER REPAIRS
(a) After repairs, confirm that the actual tire pressures
are displayed in the DATA LIST (see page TW-25).
TW
TW–22
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected Area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Tire pressure warning system
Symptom
See page
Tire pressure warning light does not illuminate, despite
tire pressure decreasing
TW-25
ID code check (Registration)
TW-13
Tire pressure warning light illuminated (Goes off during
initial check)
ECU power source circuit
TW-61
Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
Check DATA LIST (Tire inflation pressure)
TW-25
Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
ID code check (Registration)
TW-13
TC and CG terminal circuit
TW-64
ECU power source circuit
TW-61
Tire pressure warning light illuminated (Comes on
during initial check)
TW
Suspected Area
Check DATA LIST (Tire inflation pressure)
DTC check cannot be done
TW–23
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
HINT:
Inspect the connectors from the backside while the
connectors are connected.
1. CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
T16
F045856E02
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
T16-2 (IG) - T16-11 (GND)
B-R - W-B
IG power source
Ignition switch ON
10 to 16 V
T16-3 (SPD) - T16-11 (GND)
V-R - W-B
Vehicle speed signal
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
T16-4 (SIL) - T16-11 (GND)
R-Y - W-B
Diagnostic communication
terminal
T16-6 (IND) - T16-11 (GND)
P-B - W-B
Tire pressure warning light
signal
Ignition switch ON
8 to 15 V
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Intelligent tester is
connected to DLC3
8 to 15 V
T16-8 (RF5V) - T16-11 (GND)
L - W-B
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
power source
T16-7 (RDA) - T16-11 (GND)
GR - W-B
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
signal
LG-B - W-B
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
TC terminal
When terminal TC is not
connected
T16-16 (GND2) - T16-11 (GND)
T16-11 (GND) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
T16-12 (TC) - T16-11 (GND)
P-L - W-B
2.
F047507E05
Ignition switch ON
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
is not connected
10 to 14 V
8 to 15 V
Waveform 1 (Reference)
(a) Waveform
Item
GND
•
•
Contents
Terminal No. (Symbols)
T16-3 (SPD) - T16-11 (GND)
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 200 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
While driving at approximately 20 km/h
(12 mph).
TW
TW–66
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
SUSPENSION
TIRE
AND WHEEL
& AXLE
COMPONENTS
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
6.8 (69, 60 in.*lbf)
TW
TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING ECU
TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING VALVE
AND TRANSMITTER
NUT
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
GROMMET
WASHER
VALVE
CORE
CAP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131379E11
TW–67
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
LH
HEADREST
REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT NO. 2 BACK PAD LH
SEAT NO. 2
LEG COVER
TW
SEAT NO. 2 BACK COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT NO. 2
LEG COVER
SEAT NO. 3
LEG COVER
SEAT NO. 2 CUSHION
COVER LH SUB-ASSEMBLY
HOG RING
SEAT NO. 2 CUSHION PAD LH
HOG RING
Non-reusable part
B120237E03
TW–68
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
RH
SEAT NO. 2 LEG COVER
HEADREST
SEAT NO. 3 LEG COVER
SEAT NO. 2 LEG COVER
TW
SEAT NO. 2 BACK PAD RH
SEAT NO. 2 BACK COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
ASSEMBLY RH
SEAT NO. 2 CUSHION
COVER RH SUB-ASSEMBLY
HOG RING
SEAT NO. 2 CUSHION PAD RH
HOG RING
Non-reusable part
B120239E02
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
TW–69
ASSIST GRIP
ASSEMBLY
COAT HOOK RH
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
FRONT ASSIST
GRIP PLUG
TW
ROOF CONSOLE
BOX ASSEMBLY
ROOM LIGHT
ASSEMBLY NO. 1
VISOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
ROOM LIGHT
ASSEMBLY NO. 1
ASSIST GRIP
ASSEMBLY
VISOR SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
COAT HOOK LH
VISOR HOLDER
FRONT ASSIST
GRIP PLUG
FRONT ASSIST
GRIP PLUG
RH VISOR ASSEMBLY
LH VISOR ASSEMBLY
B120189E05
TW–70
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER (w/ Antenna)
W/ SLIDING ROOF
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
TW
W/ RSE
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY
DOME LIGHT LENS
B134263E02
TW–24
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before
proceeding.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECU uses the ISO 15765-4 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Terminal No. (Symbols)
7 (SIL) - 5 (SG)
TW
Terminal Description
Bus "+" line
Condition
Specified Condition
During transmission
Pulse generation
4 (CG) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
5 (SG) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
16 (BAT) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
6 (CANH) - 14 (CANL)
CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
200 Ω or higher
6 (CANH) - 4 (CG)
14 (CANL) - 4 (CG)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
200 Ω or higher
6 (CANH) - 16 (BAT)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
6 kΩ or higher
14 (CANL) - 16 (BAT)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF*
6 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the
vehicle as is for at least 1 minute and do not
operate the ignition switch, any other switches
or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester to the
DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to
use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a
problem either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem may be in the tester itself. Consult the
Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
TW–25
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
3.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
(a) DTCs (Normal mode)
(1) DTCs are memorized in the tire pressure
warning ECU and read by the blinks of the tire
pressure warning light or by using the intelligent
tester (see page TW-23).
(b) Test mode
(1) By switching from normal mode into test mode
(input signal check), you can inspect the tire
pressure warning antenna and receiver, each
tire pressure warning valve and transmitter, and
each vehicle speed sensor (see page TW-16).
4.
CHECK WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check that the tire pressure warning light comes on
for 3 seconds.
If the warning check result is not normal, proceed to
the troubleshooting for the tire pressure warning
light circuit.
Trouble Area
See procedure
Tire pressure warning light circuit
5.
Tire Pressure Warning Light
TW-58
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT CHART
HINT:
The table below indicates the state of the tire pressure
warning light after the ignition switch is turned ON.
C150462E01
Always
Immediately
after turning
ignition
switch ON
Warning light output pattern
Comes on for
3 sec.
Goes off
Comes on
Blinks (*1)
Blinks (*2)
Blinks (*3)
Blinks (*4)
Outputs DTC
Normal
{
{
-
-
-
-
-
-
Low tire
pressure
{
-
{
-
-
-
-
-
System fail
{
-
-
{
-
-
-
-
Test mode
{
-
-
-
{
-
-
-
ECU
connector
poorly
connected
-
-
-
{
-
-
-
-
TC ground
(DTC is
output)
{
-
-
-
-
-
-
{
TC ground
(DTC is not
output)
{
-
-
-
-
-
{
-
TW
TW–26
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
*1: Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.5 second
intervals.
0.5 sec.
ON
OFF
0.5 sec.
F046782E02
*2: Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.125 second
intervals.
0.125 sec.
ON
OFF
0.125 sec.
C110635E01
*3: Blinks 3 times (1 second on, 1 second off).
TW
1 sec.
ON
OFF
1 sec.
C110636E01
*4: Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.25 second
intervals.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
C145821E01
TW–72
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
SUSPENSION
TIRE
AND WHEEL
& AXLE
COMPONENTS
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
6.8 (69, 60 in.*lbf)
TW
TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING VALVE
AND TRANSMITTER
TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING ECU
NUT
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
GROMMET
WASHER
VALVE
CORE
CAP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131379E12
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW–73
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3.
REMOVE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND
TRANSMITTER
(a) Remove the valve core, cap, and release air from
the tire.
(b) After ensuring that air is sufficiently released,
remove the nut, washer that is used to fix the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter and drop the
sensor inside the tire.
(c) After dropping the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter into the tire, disengage the bead using
the shoe of the tire remover.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter due to
interference between the sensor and tire bead.
(d) Remove the bead on the upper side as in usual
operation.
(e) Take out the sensor from the tire and remove the
bead on the lower side as in usual operation.
(f) Remove the inner grommet from the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter.
HINT:
Check that no crack or damage is identified on the
grommet. If so, replace the grommet together with
the washer and nut.
Tire
Shoe
10 to 20 mm
(0.39 to 0.79 in.)
F046444E01
INSTALLATION
Print Surface
F046445E02
1.
INSTALL TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND
TRANSMITTER
(a) Insert the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter into the valve installation hole. Insert
from the inside of the rim so that the print surface
can be seen.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no visible deformation,
damage or other abnormalities on the
transmitter.
• Check that there is no foreign matter on the
inner grommet and around the rim hole.
• If installed in the reverse direction, the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter may
be damaged or fail to transmit signals when
running at high speed.
TW
TW–74
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
(b) Install the washer on the tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter from the rim side and tighten with a
nut.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no foreign matter on the
washer and nut.
• When removing the tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter if the tire is removed for
replacement, check that there is no damage
or cuts, and no foreign matter such as mud,
dirt or sand attached to the grommet. Replace
the grommet with a new one if any of the
defects mentioned above are found.
• Check that there is no oil, water or lubricant
around the rim hole, tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter, washer and nut. Failing
to do so may result in improper installation.
(c) After the tire is inflated, the valve nut may be loose.
Retighten the nut to the specified torque and then
check for air leaks with soapy water.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
Grommet
Nut
Rim
Sensor
Cap
Washer
F046446E03
TW
(d) Set the wheel disc to the mounting machine and
install the lower tire bead. At the time, position the
main body of the sensor to the shaded area shown
in the illustration.
NOTICE:
If the sensor is positioned outside this area, it
generates interference with the tire bead,
causing possible damage to the sensor.
(e) Install the upper bead.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the tire bead and tool do not
interfere with the main body of the sensor and
that the sensor is not clamped by the bead.
Rim
Rim rotating
direction
Area for the sensor
Rim
Rim rotating
direction
Area for the sensor
F046447E05
2.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSPECT TIRE
5.
REGISTRATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
HINT:
(See page TW-13)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW–75
DISPOSAL
HINT:
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter is powered
by a lithium battery. When disposing the tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter, remove the battery and dispose it
correctly.
1.
DISPOSE OF TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE
AND TRANSMITTER
(a) Insert the tip of a screwdriver into the clearance and
pry off the cover. Remove the back cover.
F046448
Lithium battery
(b) The battery and base board covered with silicone
resin are exposed. While taking out the battery, cut
off the 2 terminals which connects the battery and
base board.
Terminal
F046449E02
TW
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–27
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
CHECK DTC (USING INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and the tester ON.
(d) Read the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
DLC3
Intelligent Tester
C150424E01
2.
CG
DLC3
CHECK DTC (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4
(CG) of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
TC
H100769E05
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
Tire Pressure Warning Light
C150462E01
TW
TW–28
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(3) Read and record any DTCs from the tire
pressure warning light on the combination meter.
Refer to the illustration for examples of a normal
system code and codes 13 and 33.
HINT:
• If the tire pressure warning light does not
indicate any DTCs or the normal system
code, inspect the tire pressure warning light
circuit or TC and CG terminal circuit.
Normal System Code:
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
Code 13 and 33:
Trouble Area
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
4.5 sec.
Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
TC and CG terminal circuit
TW-64
ON
OFF
1.5 sec. 0.5 sec.
Repeat
F050628E02
3.
TW
See procedure
• If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the
same time, the lowest numbered DTC is
displayed first.
(4) Refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart (see
page TW-27) for DTC information.
(5) After completing the check, turn the ignition
switch OFF and remove SST from the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
CLEAR DTC
HINT:
After repairing the malfunctions, clear the DTCs.
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and the tester ON.
(d) Clear the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
DLC3
Intelligent Tester
C150424E01
TW–76
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
SUSPENSION
TIRE
AND WHEEL
& AXLE
COMPONENTS
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
6.8 (69, 60 in.*lbf)
TW
TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING ECU
TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING VALVE
AND TRANSMITTER
NUT
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
GROMMET
WASHER
VALVE
CORE
CAP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131379E13
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW–77
TW
COWL SIDE
TRIM BOARD RH
FRONT DOOR
SCUFF PLATE RH
INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
B120192E08
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–29
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
Tester Display
DATA LIST
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Following the display on the intelligent tester, read
"DATA LIST".
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MODE STATUS
Tire pressure warning system
mode/NORMAL or REG 2nd or
REG M or TEST
NORMAL: Normal mode
TEST: Test mode
-
MAIN TIRE
Number of main tire IDs to be registered/
0 or 1 or 2 or 3 or 4 or 5
0 to 5 should be displayed
-
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed reading/
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph),
max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on the
combination meter
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code/min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF*1
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter
ID1 is displayed
-
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code/min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF*1
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter
ID2 is displayed
-
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code/min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF*1
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter
ID3 is displayed
-
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code/min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF*1
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter
ID4 is displayed
-
REGIT ID5 CODE
Registered ID5 code/min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF*1
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter
ID5 is displayed
-
TRANS STATUS
ID code transmission status/
FINISH or NOW
FINISH or NOW
-
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
TIREPRESS1
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
Actual tire inflation pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*2
(5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
2,
TIREPRESS2
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm 14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
Actual tire inflation pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*2
(5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
TIREPRESS3
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa
(5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
Actual tire inflation pressure
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*2
TW
TW–30
Tester Display
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
TIREPRESS4
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
Actual tire inflation pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*2
(5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
2
TIREPRESS5
psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm , 14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
Actual tire inflation pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*2
(5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
TW
TIRE TEMP1
ID1 temperature in tire/
min.: -40°C (-40°F),
max.: 215°C (419°F)
Actual tire temperature
If -40°C (-40°F) is displayed, the
data have not been received.
TIRE TEMP2
ID2 temperature in tire/
min.: -40°C (-40°F),
max.: 215°C (419°F)
Actual tire temperature
If -40°C (-40°F) is displayed, the
data has not been received.
TIRE TEMP3
ID3 temperature in tire/
min.: -40°C (-40°F),
max.: 215°C (419°F)
Actual tire temperature
If -40°C (-40°F) is displayed, the
data has not been received.
TIRE TEMP4
ID4 temperature in tire/
min.: -40°C (-40°F),
max.: 215°C (419°F)
Actual tire temperature
If -40°C (-40°F) is displayed, the
data has not been received.
TIRE TEMP5
ID5 temperature in tire/
min.: -40°C (-40°F),
max.: 215°C (419°F)
Actual tire temperature
If -40°C (-40°F) is displayed, the
data has not been received.
BATT VOLT1
ID1 battery voltage/
OVER or LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT2
ID2 battery voltage/
OVER or LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT3
ID3 battery voltage/
OVER or LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT4
ID4 battery voltage/
OVER or LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT5
ID5 battery voltage/
OVER or LESS
OVER
-
# CODES
Number of DTC recorded/
min.: 0, max.: 255
0
-
HINT:
*1: Displayed only when the ID No. is not registered.
*2: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed. If the values are not displayed after a few minutes,
perform troubleshooting according to the inspection
procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25 (see page TW34).
TW–31
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
• If no abnormality is found when the parts are inspected,
inspect the tire pressure warning ECU.
• If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check,
inspect the trouble areas listed for that code. For details of
the code, refer to the "See page" below.
Tire pressure warning system
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C2111/11
Transmitter ID1 Operation Stop
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-30
C2112/12
Transmitter ID2 Operation Stop
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-30
C2113/13
Transmitter ID3 Operation Stop
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-30
C2114/14
Transmitter ID4 Operation Stop
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-30
C2115/15
Transmitter ID5 Operation Stop
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-30
No Signal from Transmitter ID1 in
Main Mode
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
No Signal from Transmitter ID2 in
Main Mode
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
No Signal from Transmitter ID3 in
Main Mode
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
No Signal from Transmitter ID4 in
Main Mode
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2125/25
No Signal from Transmitter ID5 in
Main Mode
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
C2141/41
Transmitter ID1 Error
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-42
C2142/42
Transmitter ID2 Error
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-42
C2121/21
C2122/22
C2123/23
C2124/24
TW
TW–32
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
TW-42
C2143/43
Transmitter ID3 Error
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
C2144/44
Transmitter ID4 Error
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-42
C2145/45
Transmitter ID5 Error
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-42
C2165/65
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID1
Tire
- Tires
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-46
C2166/66
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID2
Tire
- Tires
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-46
C2167/67
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID3
Tire
- Tires
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-46
C2168/68
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID4
Tire
- Tires
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-46
C2169/69
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID5
Tire
- Tires
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-46
C2171/71
Transmitter ID not Registered
Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-50
Receiver Error
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-53
Transmitter ID1 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
Transmitter ID2 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
Transmitter ID3 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
Transmitter ID4 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-34
TW
C2176/76
C2181/81
C2182/82
C2183/83
C2184/84
TW–33
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC Code
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
TW-34
TW-56
C2185/85
Transmitter ID5 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
- Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
- Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
- Wire harness or connector
- Tire pressure warning ECU
C2191/91
Vehicle Speed Signal Error (Test
Mode DTC)
- Vehicle speed sensor
- Tire pressure warning ECU
- Combination meter
- Wire harness or connector
TW
TW–34
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2111/11 Transmitter ID1 Operation Stop
DTC
C2112/12 Transmitter ID2 Operation Stop
DTC
C2113/13 Transmitter ID3 Operation Stop
DTC
C2114/14 Transmitter ID4 Operation Stop
DTC
C2115/15 Transmitter ID5 Operation Stop
DESCRIPTION
TW
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitters that are installed in the tire and wheel assemblies
measure the air pressures of the tires. The measured values are transmitted to the tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver on the body as radio waves and then sent to the tire pressure warning ECU. The
ECU compares the measured air pressure values with the air pressure threshold. When the measured air
pressure value is less than this threshold, the warning light in the combination meter comes on. The tire
pressure warning ECU stores a DTC when the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter stops
transmitting signals. At this time, forcibly transmit the signals by releasing the tire pressure rapidly. The
stored DTC is cleared when the signal transmission is resumed.
DTC Code
Detection Condition
C2111/11
C2112/12
C2113/13
C2114/14
C2115/15
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitters
stop transmitting signals
Trouble Area
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is
malfunctioning because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
TW–35
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Front RH)
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Front LH)
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Rear RH)
11
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Rear LH)
GND
TW
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Spare)
5
8
RF5V
+5V
7
1
RDA
GND
RDA
16
4
GND2
T17
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
C150483E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and write them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU and/or valve and transmitter has been replaced.
TW–36
1
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
PERFORM FORCED TRANSMISSION OF TRANSMITTER ID OF ALL WHEELS
(a) Set the tire pressure to the specified value (see page
TW-1).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(d) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure /
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS1
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Diagnostic Note
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
or -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
is displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure /
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TW
TIREPRESS2
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
or -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
is displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure /
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS3
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
or -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
is displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure /
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS4
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
Actual tire inflation pressure
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
or -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
is displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure /
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure
cm2, 0 psi), Relative pressure / -100 kPa
TIREPRESS5
(-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5
kgf/cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure /
Actual tire inflation pressure
or -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
is displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed. If the values are not displayed after a few
minutes, perform troubleshooting according to the
inspection procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25
(see page TW-34).
(e) Rapidly reduce the tire pressure for each wheel at least
40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) within 30 seconds.
(1) Check that each tire pressure data displayed on the
intelligent tester screen has changed.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–37
OK:
Each tire pressure data displayed on the
intelligent tester screen will change to the
value of the tire pressure.
NOTICE:
• It takes about 2 or 3 minutes to display the
updated tire pressure data.
• When the "TIREPRESS" data has not
changed, reset the tire pressure to the
appropriate specified value and rotate the tire
90 to 270 degrees (including the spare tire).
Then rapidly release the tire pressure and
recheck it.
(2) After confirming that all of the tire pressure data
displayed on the intelligent tester screen has
changed, set the tire pressure to the appropriate
specified values.
HINT:
If the tire pressure data displayed on the intelligent
tester screen has not changed after rechecking,
inspect the other problem (malfunction in
transmission or reception function) (see page TW34)
NG
OK
END
INSPECT OTHER PROBLEM
(MALFUNCTION IN TRANSMISSION OR
RECEPTION FUNCTION) (See page TW-34)
TW
TW–38
TW
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2121/21 No Signal from Transmitter ID1 in Main Mode
DTC
C2122/22 No Signal from Transmitter ID2 in Main Mode
DTC
C2123/23 No Signal from Transmitter ID3 in Main Mode
DTC
C2124/24 No Signal from Transmitter ID4 in Main Mode
DTC
C2125/25 No Signal from Transmitter ID5 in Main Mode
DTC
C2181/81 Transmitter ID1 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2182/82 Transmitter ID2 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2183/83 Transmitter ID3 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2184/84 Transmitter ID4 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2185/85 Transmitter ID5 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitters that are installed in the tire and wheel assemblies
measure the air pressure of the tires. The measured values are transmitted to the tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver on the body as radio waves and then sent to the tire pressure warning ECU. The
ECU compares the measured air pressure values with the air pressure threshold. When the measured air
pressure value is less than this threshold, the warning light in the combination meter comes on.
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitters constantly send radio waves to the tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver.
Under the conditions below, the tire pressure warning antenna and receiver is unable to receive the
signals from the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters, and a DTC is stored.
• Facilities or devices that use similar radio frequencies are located in the vicinity of the vehicle.
• Devices using similar radio frequencies are used in the vehicle.
HINT:
When no signals are received for 51 minutes or more, a DTC is output.
DTCs from C2121/21 to C2125/25 can only be cleared by using the tester. DTCs from C2181/81 to
C2185/85 can be cleared when the transmitter in the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter sends a
forced transmission signal or test mode ends. DTCs from C2181/81 to C2185/85 are output only in test
mode.
DTC Code
Detection Condition
C2121/21
C2122/22
C2123/23
C2124/24
C2125/25
These DTCs are detected when no signals are received
for 51 minutes or more, and then vehicle is driven at 8
km/h (5 mph) or higher and the ECU receives no
signals for 12 minutes or more.
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
Test mode procedure is performed.
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Wire harness or connector
Tire pressure warning ECU
C2181/81
C2182/82
C2183/83
C2184/84
C2185/85
Trouble Area
TW–39
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is
malfunctioning because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Front RH)
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Front LH)
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Rear RH)
11
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Rear LH)
TW
GND
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and
Receiver (for Spare)
5
8
RF5V
+5V
7
1
RDA
GND
RDA
16
4
GND2
T17
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
T16
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
C150483E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and write them down before removal.
TW–40
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU and/or valve and transmitter has been replaced.
1
CHECK FREQUENCY RECEIVING CONDITION
(a) Check if the vehicle is located in areas such as the ones
described below:
(1) Facilities or devices that use similar radio
frequencies are located in the vicinity of the vehicle.
HINT:
If the vehicle is located in areas described above,
the tire pressure warning light may come on only in
a particular area.
(2) Devices using similar radio frequencies are used in
the vehicle.
OK:
Facilities, or devices that use similar radio
frequencies are not located in the vicinity of
the vehicle.
HINT:
Radio frequency may be interrupted due to
surroundings or devices installed by user.
TW
NG
CHECK IF ANY DEVICE IS INSTALLED BY
USER
OK
2
IDENTIFY TRANSMITTER CORRESPONDING TO DTC
(a) Set the tire pressure to the appropriate specified values
(see page TW-1).
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(e) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS1
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS2
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
cm2, 78 psi)
Actual tire inflation
pressure
Diagnostic Note
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
TW–41
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
2
TIREPRESS3
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm , -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
2
TIREPRESS4
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm , -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS5
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
Diagnostic Note
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed.
(f) Rapidly reduce the tire pressure for each wheel at least
40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) within 30 seconds.
(g) Check the DATA LIST.
NOTICE:
• It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values
are displayed.
• When no "TIREPRESS" data has changed, reset
the tire pressure to the appropriate specified
value and rotate the tire 90 to 270 degrees. Then
rapidly release the tire pressure and recheck it.
• Record the "TIREPRESS" data transmitter ID that
corresponds to each tire.
(h) After confirming that "TIREPRESS" data for one tire (ID1
to ID5) has changed, repeat this procedure one by one.
Identify the transmitter that corresponds to the DTC.
Result
Condition
One or more of transmitters abnormal
A
All normal
B
All abnormal
C
A
B
C
Proceed to
Go to step 4
END
TW
TW–42
3
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECU - RECEIVER)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning ECU)
7 (RDA)
Rear view of wire harness connector:
(to Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver)
T16
T17
8 (RF5V)
5 (+5V)
1 (RDA)
16 (GND2)
4 (GND)
C150484E01
(a) Disconnect the T16 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the T17 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
TW
Tester Connection
Condition
T16-7 (RDA) - T17-1 (RDA)
Always
T16-8 (RF5V) - T17-5 (+5V)
Always
T16-16 (GND2) - T17-4 (GND)
Always
T16-7 (RDA) or T17-1 (RDA) - Body
ground
Always
T16-8 (RF5V) or T17-5 (+5V) - Body
ground
Always
T16-16 (GND2) or T17-4 (GND) Body ground
Always
NG
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
INSPECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Select REGIT ID CODE by following the prompts
displayed on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID1 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID2 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
TW–43
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID3 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID4 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
REGIT ID5 CODE
Registered ID5 code/
min.: 0, max.: FFFFFF*
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID5 is displayed
*: Displayed only when the ID
No. is not registered.
(e) Check the ID number on the identified transmitter by
removing it from the tire and wheel.
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and Transmitter:
Transmitter ID
(7 Digit Number)
TW
E128762E10
(f)
Confirm that the ID number on the transmitter and
recorded transmitter ID match.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Match
A
Do not match
B
B
Go to step 6
A
5
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
(a) Replace the pressure warning valve and transmitter (see
page TW-73).
NEXT
6
REGISTRATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Perform registration (see page TW-13).
NEXT
7
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
TW–44
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(d) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS1
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS2
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS3
TW
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm
2,
-14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS4
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS5
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
cm2, 78 psi)
Actual tire inflation
pressure
Diagnostic Note
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or
-100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
All tire pressure readings are equal to specified values.
A
Tire pressure values are not displayed.
B
A
END
B
8
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
(a) Replace the tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
(see page TW-70).
NEXT
TW–45
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
9
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS1
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4
kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS2
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4
kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS3
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4
kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS4
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4
kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS5
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4
kgf/cm2, 78 psi)
Actual tire inflation
pressure
Diagnostic Note
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
All tire pressure readings are equal to specified values.
A
Tire pressure values are not displayed.
B
B
A
END
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(See page TW-78)
TW
TW–46
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2141/41 Transmitter ID1 Error
DTC
C2142/42 Transmitter ID2 Error
DTC
C2143/43 Transmitter ID3 Error
DTC
C2144/44 Transmitter ID4 Error
DTC
C2145/45 Transmitter ID5 Error
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitters that are installed in the tire and wheel assemblies
measure the air pressure of the tires. The measured values are transmitted to the tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver on the body as radio waves and then sent to the tire pressure warning ECU. The
ECU compares the measured air pressure values with the air pressure threshold. When the measured air
pressure value is less than this threshold, the warning light in the combination meter comes on.
When the internal circuit of a tire pressure warning valve and transmitter is malfunctioning, one of these
DTCs are output.
TW
DTC Code
C2141/41
C2142/42
C2143/43
C2144/44
C2145/45
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
If an "ERROR" signal is received 3 times consecutively, the
tire pressure warning valve and transmitter will be judged as
defective and a DTC will be output. This will happen in
situations where the inflation pressure is outside the absolute
pressure range 0 to 637.5 kPa (0 to 6.5 kgf/cm2, 0 to 92.5
psi), outside the relative pressure range -100 to 537.5 kPa (-1
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
to 5.4 kgf/cm2, -14 to 78 psi), the temperature inside the tire
is outside the specified range -40 to 120°C (-40 to 253°F), or
an error occurs in the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter or the surrounding area.
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is
malfunctioning because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and write them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform registration (see page TW-13) of the transmitter IDs into the tire
pressure warning ECU after the ECU and/or valve and transmitter has been replaced.
1
IDENTIFY TRANSMITTER CORRESPONDING TO DTC
(a) Set the tire pressure to the specified value (see page
TW-1).
(b) Display the "TIREPRESS" data for each wheel using the
intelligent tester.
TW–47
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(c) Rapidly reduce the tire pressure for each wheel at least
40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) within 30 seconds. If
"TIREPRESS" data displayed on the tester (ID1 to ID5)
does not change, the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter corresponding to the unchanged
"TIREPRESS" data was the cause of the output DTC.
HINT:
• Identify the malfunctioning tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter by repeatedly decreasing the tire
pressure for each tire.
• Record which "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5)
corresponds to which tire.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS1
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS2
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS3
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS4
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
2
TIREPRESS5
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm , -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
Diagnostic Note
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or 100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or 100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or 100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or 100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is
displayed for absolute pressure or 100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is
displayed for relative pressure,
data has not been received.*
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed. If the values are not displayed after a few
minutes, perform troubleshooting according to the
inspection procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25
(see page TW-34).
(d) Check the DATA LIST.
Result
Condition
Detection Condition
One of "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5) changed.
Normal
"TIREPRESS" data did not change.
Transmitter corresponding to DTC
TW
TW–48
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
NOTICE:
• When "TIREPRESS" data has not changed, reset
the tire pressure to the appropriate specified
value and rotate the tire 90 to 270 degrees. Then
forcibly transmit the transmitter ID and recheck.
• Record the transmitter ID and position of
transmitters that are normal.
(e) When the "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5) has changed,
repeat this procedure to identify the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter that corresponds to the
DTC.
(f) When all of the "TIREPRESS" data (ID1 to ID5) have
changed, identify the malfunctioning tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter using recorded ID
numbers and output DTC.
(g) Set the tire pressures to the appropriate specified
values.
NEXT
2
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW
(a) Replace the identified tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter with a new one (see page TW-73).
HINT:
• Before installing a new tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter, read and write down its transmitter
ID.
• The IDs for the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitters that are not replaced should be checked
using the tester and recorded.
NEXT
3
REGISTRATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Register the transmitter ID for all wheels (see page TW13).
NEXT
4
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
TW–49
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(d) Select "TIREPRESS" by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Tester Display
Measurement Item/Display
Normal Condition
ID1 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS1
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID2 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS2
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID3 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS3
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID4 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS4
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
Actual tire inflation
pressure
cm2, 78 psi)
ID5 tire inflation pressure/
min.: Absolute pressure / 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi),
TIREPRESS5
Relative pressure / -100 kPa (-1 kgf/cm2, -14 psi)
max.: Absolute pressure / 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/cm2,
92.5 psi), Relative pressure / 537.5 kPa (5.4 kgf/
cm2, 78 psi)
Actual tire inflation
pressure
Diagnostic Note
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
If 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi) is displayed
for absolute pressure or -100 kPa (-1
kgf/cm2, -14 psi) is displayed for
relative pressure, data has not been
received.*
HINT:
*: It may take about 2 or 3 minutes until the values are
displayed. If the values are not displayed after a few
minutes, perform troubleshooting according to the
inspection procedure for DTCs C2121/21 to C2125/25
(see page TW-34).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
All tire pressure readings are equal to specified values.
A
Tire pressure values are not displayed.
B
B
A
END
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(See page TW-78)
TW
BC–4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Speed Sensor
(with Each Wheel)
Motor Relay
Pump Motor
Stop Light Switch
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
BC
Stop Light
Operation Relay
Accumulator
Pressure Sensor
Parking Brake Switch
Solenoid Relay
Solenoid
(Switching)
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Solenoid (Control)
AUTO LSD Switch (*1)
Skid Control
ECU
Master Cylinder Solenoid
C132864E01
BC–5
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Combination Meter Assembly
Downhill Assist
Control Switch (*3)
ABS Warning Light
Skid Control
ECU
VSC TRAC Warning Light
4WD Control (L4)
Switch (*3)
BRAKE Warning Light
SLIP Indicator Light
4WD Control (4WD)
Switch (*3)
VSC OFF Indicator Light (*2)
AUTO LSD Indicator Light (*1)
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
Downhill Assist Control
Indicator Light (*3)
Center Differential
Lock Switch (*2)
BC
Speedometer
Center Differential Lock
Indicator Light (*2)
Skid Control Buzzer
Throttle Position
Sensor
Steering Angle Sensor
Yaw Rate and
Acceleration Sensor
ECM
Engine Revolution
Sensor
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
CAN Communication System
(*1): 2WD (*2): 4WD (*3): Multi Mode 4WD
C149935E01
Transmitting ECU (Transmitter)
Receiving ECU
Signals
Communication Method
ECM
Skid control ECU
Throttle position signal
CAN communication system
ECM
Skid control ECU
Engine revolution signal
CAN communication system
ECM
Skid control ECU
Accelerator pedal position signal
CAN communication system
BC–6
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Transmitting ECU (Transmitter)
Receiving ECU
Signals
Communication Method
Skid control ECU
ECM
Yaw rate and acceleration signal
CAN communication system
Skid control ECU
ECM
Steering angle signal
CAN communication system
Skid control ECU
ECM
Engine torque request signal
CAN communication system
BC–7
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• The skid control ECU is a single unit with hydraulic
brake booster.
• The yaw rate and acceleration sensors are combined
in a single unit. This unit communicates with the skid
control ECU through CAN communication.
(a) ABS with EBD, BA, TRAC and VSC operation
(1) The skid control ECU calculates vehicle stability
tendency based on the signals from the speed
sensor, yaw rate and acceleration sensor and
steering angle sensor. In addition, it evaluates
the results of the calculations to determine
whether any control actions (control of the
engine output torque by electronic throttle
control and of the wheel brake pressure by the
brake actuator) should be implemented.
(2) The SLIP indicator blinks and the skid control
buzzer sounds to inform the driver that the VSC
system is operating. The SLIP indicator also
blinks when TRAC is operating, and the
operation being performed is displayed.
ACTIVE SAFETY
(a) ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)
The ABS helps prevent the wheels from locking
when the brakes are applied firmly or when braking
on a slippery surface.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Each Speed
Sensor
Skid Control ECU
Solenoid Valve
ABS Warning
Light
C124752E02
BC
BC–8
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Operation description
The skid control ECU detects wheel lock condition
by receiving vehicle speed signals from each speed
sensor, and sends control signals to the pump motor
and solenoid valve. The pump motor and solenoid
valve avoid wheel lock by controlling the oil
pressure of each wheel cylinder.
The ABS warning light comes on when the ABS
system is malfunctioning.
(b) EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution)
The EBD control utilizes ABS, realizing proper
brake force distribution between the front and rear
wheels in accordance with driving conditions.
In addition, when braking while cornering, it also
controls the brake forces of the right and left wheels,
helping to maintain vehicle behavior.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Solenoid Valve
BC
Each Speed
Sensor
Skid Control ECU
Rear Wheel
Cylinder
ABS Warning
Light
BRAKE Warning
Light
C124753E02
Operation description
The skid control ECU receives the speed signal
from each speed sensor to detect the slip condition
of the wheels and sends the control signal to the
solenoid.
The solenoid valve controls oil pressure of the rear
wheel cylinder and splits the control power properly
between the rear wheels and the right and left
wheels.
Both of the ABS and BRAKE warning lights come
on to indicate a malfunction in the EBD system.
BC–9
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) BA (Brake Assist)
The primary purpose of the brake assist system is to
provide an auxiliary brake force to assist the driver
who cannot generate a large enough brake force
during emergency braking, thus helping to maximize
the vehicle's braking performance.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Solenoid Valve
Each Speed
Sensor
Skid Control ECU
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
BC
ABS Warning
Light
C124754E02
Operation description
The skid control ECU receives the speed signal
from each speed sensor and the oil pressure signal
from the master cylinder pressure sensor to
determine whether brake assist is necessary or not.
If brake assist is deemed necessary, the ECU sends
control signals to the pump motor and solenoid. The
pump and the solenoid valve then control the
pressure applied to each wheel cylinder.
The ABS warning light comes on to indicate a
malfunction in the BA system.
BC–10
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(d) VSC (Vehicle Stability Control)
The VSC system helps prevent the vehicle from
slipping sideways as a result of strong front wheel
skid or strong rear wheel skid during cornering.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Each Speed
Sensor
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Solenoid Valve
Yaw Rate and
Acceleration Sensor
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
Skid Control ECU
VSC OFF
Indicator Light (*1)
Steering Angle
Sensor
BC
SLIP Indicator
Light
ECM
Skid Control
Buzzer
(*1): 4WD
CAN Communication System
C124755E03
Operation description
The skid control ECU determines vehicle condition
by receiving signals from the speed sensor, yaw
rate and acceleration sensor and steering angle
sensor. The skid control ECU controls engine torque
through the ECM via CAN communication, and oil
pressure through the pump and solenoid valve.
The SLIP indicator light blinks and the skid control
buzzer sounds when the system is operating. Both
of the VSC TRAC warning light and the VSC OFF
indicator light (4WD) come on to indicate a
malfunction in the VSC system.
BC–11
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
3.
DRIVING PERFORMANCE
(a) TRAC (Traction Control)
The TRAC system helps prevent the drive wheels
from slipping if the driver presses down on the
accelerator pedal excessively when starting off or
accelerating on a slippery surface.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Each Speed
Sensor
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Solenoid Valve
Yaw Rate and
Acceleration Sensor
Skid Control ECU
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
Steering Angle
Sensor
BC
SLIP Indicator
Light
ECM
CAN Communication System
C124756E03
Operation description
The skid control ECU detects vehicle's slip condition
by receiving signals from the speed sensor and
ECM via CAN communication. The skid control
ECU controls engine torque through the ECM via
CAN communication, and oil pressure through the
pump and solenoid valve.
The SLIP indicator light blinks when the system is
operating. Both of the VSC TRAC warning light and
SLIP indicator light come on to indicate a
malfunction in the TRAC system.
BC–12
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) A-TRAC (Active Traction Control) (Multi Mode 4WD)
During rugged off-road driving, this function controls
the engine output and the brake fluid pressure that
is applied to the slipping wheel, and distributes the
drive force that would have been lost through the
slippage to the remaining wheels in order to achieve
a LSD (Limited Slip Differential) effect. As a result,
the vehicle's off-road drivability and ability to free
itself from mogul have been increased.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Each Speed
Sensor
Solenoid Valve
Skid Control ECU
BC
ECM
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
SLIP Indicator
Light
CAN Communication System
C124757E03
Operation description
The SLIP indicator light blinks when the system is
operating. Both of the VSC TRAC warning light and
SLIP indicator light come on to indicate a
malfunction in the A-TRAC system.
(c) AUTO-LSD (Auto Limited Slip Differential) (2WD)
The AUTO LSD will operate with the AUTO LSD
switch on and the accelerator pedal depressed.
The TRAC system is used to restrain brake
pressure and reduce differential move, thus
transmitting drive torque to the other drive wheel to
ensure startability under the following conditions:
• Wheels run off the road.
• Drive wheels run idle when starting on a slope
with one wheel on snow/ice.
HINT:
Depressing the brake pedal cancels control of the
AUTO LSD system.
BC–13
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Each Speed
Sensor
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
AUTO LSD Switch
Solenoid Valve
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
Yaw Rate and
Acceleration Sensor
Skid Control ECU
SLIP Indicator
Light
Steering Angle
Sensor
BC
AUTO LSD
Indicator Light
ECM
CAN Communication System
C132863E02
Operation description
The SLIP indicator light blinks and the AUTO LSD
indicator light comes on when the system is
operating.
Both of the VSC TRAC warning light and SLIP
indicator light come on to indicate a malfunction in
the AUTO LSD system.
(d) Downhill Assist Control (Multi Mode 4WD)
When the downhill assist control switch is pressed
with transfer in low (L4) range and without
accelerator and brake pedals operation, downhill
assist control activates to effect 4-wheel hydraulic
pressure control, in order to maintain a constant low
vehicle speed without causing the wheels to
become locked. Thus, the vehicle can descend a
steep hill in a stable manner.
HINT:
Depressing the accelerator and brake pedal cancels
control of the downhill assist control system.
BC–14
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Begins operating when driving down on a slope at a
speed of 16 mph (25 km/h) or less with the engine
brake applied.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Each Speed
Sensor
Pump Motor
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Solenoid Valve
Downhill Assist
Control Switch
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
Skid Control ECU
BC
4WD Control
(L4) Switch
SLIP Indicator
Light
ECM
: CAN Communication System
C124758E07
Operation description
The SLIP indicator light blinks and the downhill
assist control indicator light and stop light come on
when the system is in operation.
The VSC TRAC warning light comes on and the
downhill assist control indicator light blinks to
indicate a malfunction in the downhill assist control
system.
BC–15
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Hill-start Assist Control
When the vehicle starts off on a steep hill, hill-start
assist control detects the backward descent of the
vehicle and effects 4-wheel hydraulic pressure
control to reduce the backward speed of the vehicle.
Maximum 5 seconds after the control has started,
fluid pressure is gradually released and control will
be complete.
HINT:
Depressing the brake pedal cancels control of the
hill-start assist control system.
Does not operate when the shift lever is in the P or
N position, or when the vehicle is running/rolling
back up a slope with the shift lever in the R position.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Pump Motor
BC
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Each Speed
Sensor
Solenoid Valve
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
Skid Control ECU
SLIP Indicator
Light
ECM
Skid Control
Buzzer
: CAN Communication System
C124759E04
Operation description
The SLIP indicator light blinks, the stop light comes
on, and the skid control buzzer sounds when the
system is in operation.
The VSC TRAC warning light comes on when the
hill-start assist control system is malfunctioning.
BC–16
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
The intelligent tester can be used at step 3, 5, 6, 9, 12, and
15.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
DTC CHECK AND CLEAR AND FREEZE FRAME DATA
NEXT
BC
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
NEXT
5
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check for output DTCs.
HINT:
The ECM of this system is connected to the CAN
communication system. Therefore, before starting
troubleshooting, make sure to check that there is no
trouble in the CAN communication system.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
CAN communication system DTC is not output
A
CAN communication system DTC is output
B
B
A
6
NEXT
DTC CHECK AND CLEAR
INSPECT CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
7
BC–17
PROBLEM SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Symptom does not occur
A
Symptom occurs
B
B
GO TO STEP 9
A
8
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
9
DTC CHECK (OTHER THAN CAN SYSTEM DTC)
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
10
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
GO TO STEP 12
11
DTC CHART
NEXT
12
NEXT
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
GO TO STEP 11
BC
BC–18
13
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
14
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
15
NEXT
END
BC
CONFIRMATION TEST
BC–52
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
• If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the circuit indicated by the DTC. For details of each code,
turn to the page for the respective DTC No. in the DTC
chart.
• Inspect the fuse and relay before investigating the trouble
areas as shown in the table below.
DTC Chart of ABS:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Areas
See page
BC-53
Front Speed Sensor RH Circuit
1. Right front speed sensor
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
5. Master cylinder solenoid
BC-53
Front Speed Sensor LH Circuit
1. Left front speed sensor
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
5. Master cylinder solenoid
BC-62
Rear Speed Sensor RH Circuit
1. Right rear speed sensor
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
5. Master cylinder solenoid
BC-62
Rear Speed Sensor LH Circuit
1. Left rear speed sensor
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
5. Master cylinder solenoid
C0226/21
SFR Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SFRH or SFRR circuit
BC-71
C0236/22
SFL Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SFLH or SFLR circuit
BC-71
C0246/23
SRR Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SRRH or SRRR circuit
BC-71
C0256/24
SRL Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SRLH or SRLR circuit
BC-71
C0278/11
1. ABS SOL fuse
2. ABS solenoid relay
3. ABS solenoid relay circuit
4. Master cylinder solenoid
BC-74
Open or Short Circuit in ABS
Solenoid Relay Circuit
C0279/12
1. ABS SOL fuse
2. ABS solenoid relay
3. ABS solenoid relay circuit
4. Master cylinder solenoid
BC-74
Short to B+ in ABS Solenoid
Relay Circuit
1. Brake fluid level
2. Brake fluid level warning switch
3. Brake fluid level warning switch
circuit
BC-79
C1202/58
Brake Fluid Level Low / Open
Circuit in Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch Circuit
C1225/25
SMC Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SMCF circuit
BC-71
C1226/26
SPC Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SREA circuit
BC-71
C1227/27
SRC Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. SREC circuit
BC-71
C1228/28
STR Solenoid Circuit
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. STR circuit
BC-71
C0200/31 (*1)
C0205/32 (*1)
C0210/33 (*1)
BC
C0215/34 (*1)
BC–53
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Areas
See page
BC-53
C1235/35
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip
of Front Speed Sensor RH
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. Right front speed sensor
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
C1236/36
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. Left front speed sensor
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
BC-53
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip
of Front Speed Sensor LH
C1238/38
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. Right rear speed sensor
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
BC-62
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip
of Rear Speed Sensor RH
C1239/39
1. Master cylinder solenoid
2. Left rear speed sensor
3. Speed sensor rotor
4. Sensor installation
BC-62
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip
of Rear Speed Sensor LH
BC-94
Low Battery Positive Voltage
1. Battery
2. ECU-IG fuse
3. Charging system
4. Power source circuit
BC-98
IG2 Power Source Circuit
1. Battery
2. IC regulator
3. Power source circuit
4. IGN fuse
BC-91
Acceleration Sensor Stuck
Malfunction
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor circuit
3. CAN communication system
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor circuit
3. CAN communication system
BC-91
Open or Short in Deceleration
Sensor Circuit
BC-91
Acceleration Sensor Output
Malfunction
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor circuit
3. CAN communication system
BC-101
C1246/46
Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor
Malfunction
1. Master cylinder pressure
sensor
2. Master cylinder pressure
sensor circuit
3. Master cylinder solenoid
4. Stop light switch circuit
Open in Stop Light Switch Circuit
1. Stop light switch
2. Stop light switch circuit
3. Rear combination light (stop
light) assembly
BC-104
C1249/49
C1251/51 (*1, 3)
Open in Pump Motor Circuit
Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor circuit
BC-109
C1252/52 (*2, 3)
1. Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor
2. Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor circuit
3. Accumulator pressure sensor
BC-111
Brake Booster Pump Motor on
Time Abnormally Long
1. Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor
2. Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor circuit
BC-115
Hydro Booster Pump Motor Relay
Malfunction
C1241/41
C1242/42
C1243/43 (*1)
C1244/44
C1245/45 (*1)
C1253/53
(*2)
BC
BC–54
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Areas
See page
BC-119
Pressure Switch Circuit
1. Hydraulic brake booster
2. Accumulator pressure sensor
3. Master cylinder pressure
sensor
BC-122
Accumulator Low Pressure
1. Hydraulic brake booster
2. Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor
3. Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor circuit
4. Accumulator pressure sensor
C1257/57 (*2)
IG Power Source
Hydraulic brake booster pump
motor circuit
BC-125
Transfer "L4" Position Switch
Circuit
1. 4WD control (L4) switch
2. 4WD control (L4) switch circuit
3. 4WD control ECU
BC-132
C1268/68 (*4)
Different Diameter Tire
Malfunction
1. Speed sensor
2. Speed sensor rotor
3. Speed sensor circuit
4. Tire size
BC-137
C1337/37
C1381/97
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor power source circuit
3. CAN communication system
BC-91
Yaw Rate and / or Acceleration
Sensor Power Supply Voltage
Malfunction
U0073/94
Control Module Communication
Bus OFF
Wire harness
U0124/95
Lost Communication with Lateral
Acceleration Sensor Module
1. Wire harness
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
C1254/54
C1256/56 (*2, 3)
BC
Detection Item
BC-156
BC-156
(*1), (*2):
Even after the trouble areas are repaired, the ABS warning
light will not go off unless the following operations are
performed.
• (*1):
(a) Drive the vehicle at 12 mph (20 km/h) for 30 seconds or
more and check that the ABS warning light goes off.
(b) Clear the DTC.
• (*2):
(a) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition for 5 seconds
or more and depress the brake pedal lightly 2 or 3 times.
(b) Repeat the above operations 3 times or more and
check that the ABS warning light goes off.
(c) Clear the DTC.
HINT:
• In some cases, the intelligent tester cannot be used
when the ABS warning light remains on.
• When U0073/94, U0100/65, U0123/62, U0124/95 or
U0126/63 is output, inspect and repair the trouble areas
indicated by these codes first.
*
( 3): The skid control buzzer sounds.
(*4): Multi Mode 4WD
DTC Chart of VSC:
DTC No.
C1201/51
Detection Item
Engine Control System
Malfunction
Trouble Areas
Engine control system
See page
BC-78
BC–55
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Areas
See page
BC-79
C1202/52
Brake Fluid Level Low / Open
Circuit in Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch Circuit
1. Brake fluid level
2. Brake fluid level warning switch
3. Brake fluid level warning switch
circuit
C1203/53
ECM Communication Circuit
Malfunction
ECM
BC-83
C1210/36
Zero Point Calibration of Yaw
Rate Sensor Undone
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Zero point calibration undone
3. Park / Neutral position switch
(P) circuit
C1223/43
ABS Control System Malfunction
ABS control system
BC-87
BC-88
Steering Angle Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
1. Steering angle sensor
2. Steering angle sensor circuit
3. Steering angle sensor power
supply
4. CAN communication system
BC-91
Stuck in Deceleration Sensor
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor circuit
3. CAN communication system
BC-91
Yaw Rate Sensor Malfunction
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor circuit
3. CAN communication system
BC-126
Transfer 4WD Position Switch
Circuit
1. 4WD control (4WD) switch
2. 4WD control (4WD) switch
circuit
3. 4WD control ECU
C1290/66
Steering Angle Sensor Zero Point
Malfunction
Steering angle sensor
C1336/39
1. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
2. Zero point calibration undone
3. Park / Neutral position switch
(P) circuit
BC-83
Zero Point Calibration of
Acceleration Sensor Undone
BC-139
Center Differential Lock Circuit
1. Center diff. lock switch
2. Center diff. lock switch circuit
3. Center diff. lock indicator light
circuit
4. 4WD control ECU
C1380/64
Stop Light Control Relay
Malfunction
1. Stop light operation relay
2. Stop light operation relay circuit
BC-147
U0100/65
Lost Communication with ECM /
PCM
Wire harness
Lost Communication with Yaw
Rate Sensor Module
1. Wire harness
2. Yaw rate and acceleration
sensor
BC-156
U0123/62
U0126/63
Lost Communication with
Steering Angle Sensor Module
1. Wire harness
2. Steering angle sensor
BC-156
C1231/31
C1232/32
C1234/34
C1258/58 (*4)
C1340/47 (*5)
Detection Item
BC-82
BC-88
BC-156
(*4): Multi Mode 4WD
(*5): 4WD
HINT:
In some cases, the intelligent tester cannot be used when the
VSC TRAC warning light remains on.
BC
BC–56
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C0200/31 Front Speed Sensor RH Circuit
DTC
C0205/32 Front Speed Sensor LH Circuit
DTC
C1235/35
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Front
Speed Sensor RH
DTC
C1236/36
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Front
Speed Sensor LH
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are
used to control the ABS, BA, TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist and hill-start assist
control systems. This speed sensor contains a sensor IC, which consists of 2 MREs (Magnetic
Resistance Element). The speed sensor rotor, which consists of 48 sets of N and S poles that are
arranged in a circle, is integrated with the inner race of the hub bearing.
To detect the rotation direction, the output waves are used to determine the relationship of the pulses that
are generated by 2 MREs. Upon receiving this signal, the sensor IC outputs a forward or backward wave
to the ECU.
BC
Speed Sensor
MRE A
(+)
Sensor IC
To ECU
MRE B
(-)
Speed Sensor Rotor
(Bearing Inner Race)
Low speed
High speed
2.6 V
1.4 V
0.7 V
Backward
Forward
I042838E01
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C0200/31
C0205/32
When any of the following conditions is detected:
1. At a vehicle speed of 6 mph (10 km/h) or more,
pulses are not input for 1 second.
2. Momentary interruption of the speed sensor signal
occurs at least 255 times when switching the ignition
switch ON and OFF.
3. Continuous noise occurs in speed sensor signals at
a vehicle speed of 12 mph (20 km/h) or more.
4. Speed sensor signal circuit is open for 0.12 seconds
or more.
5. 3 of the wheel sensors detect normal reversing
signals, and the other wheel sensor detects malfunction
signals 75 times with IG ON while reversing at 3 km/h.
6. Rotating direction of each wheel changes 7 times
within 0.006 seconds with IG ON while driving at 10 km/
h or more.
7. Rotating direction of one of the wheels is not the
same as that of the other wheels for 1 second while
driving at 30 km/h or more.
8. Reversing signal is output for 1 second or more while
driving at 100 km/h or more.
9. Rotating direction of one of the wheels is not
detected normally, and the rotating direction of each of
the other wheels is not the same for 1 second while
driving at 30 km/h or more.
•
•
•
•
•
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Speed sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Master cylinder solenoid
C1235/35
C1236/36
Continuous noise occurs in speed sensor signals when
vehicle speed is 12 mph (20 km/h) or more for 5
seconds or more.
•
•
•
•
Right front and left front speed sensor
Speed sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Master cylinder solenoid
BC–57
Trouble Area
HINT:
• DTC C0200/31 and C1235/35 are for the right front speed sensor.
• DTC C0205/32 and C1236/36 are for the left front speed sensor.
BC
BC–58
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Front Speed Sensor RH
1
3
S28
FR+
17
S28
FR-
18
S28
FL+
4
S28
FL-
2
Front Speed Sensor LH
1
2
BC
C114554E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION OF FRONT
SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN FR
Speed sensor open detection
(FR)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN FL
Speed sensor open detection
(FL)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
(d) Check for any momentary interruption in the wire
harness and connector corresponding to a DTC (See
page BC-18).
OK:
There are no momentary interruptions.
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–59
HINT:
Perform the above inspection before removing the sensor
and connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT)
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (FRONT SPEED SENSOR)
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
WHEEL SPD FR
Wheel speed sensor (FR) reading
/Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h), Max.: 202
mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD FL
Wheel speed sensor (FL)
reading/ Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h),
Max.: 202 mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
(a) Check that there is no difference between the speed
value output from the speed sensor displayed on the
intelligent tester and the speed value displayed on the
speedometer when driving the vehicle.
OK:
The speed value output from the speed sensor
displayed on the intelligent tester is the same as
the actual vehicle speed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
PERFORM TEST MODE (SIGNAL CHECK)
(a) Check if test mode (signal check) DTCs are detected.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Test mode (signal check) DTC is output
A
Test mode (signal check) DTC is not output
B
B
A
Go to step 10
BC
BC–60
4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a) Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
There is no clearance between the sensor and the
front steering knuckle.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement (See
page BC-23).
8.3 N*m
(85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
No clearance
OK
NG
I044006E04
NG
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR
CORRECTLY
OK
5
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR TIP
(a) Remove the front speed sensor (See page BC-211).
(b) Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign matter on the sensor tip.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after cleaning/
replacement (See page BC-23).
BC
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE FRONT SPEED
SENSOR
OK
6
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Front Speed Sensor:
2
1
A10 :RH
A9 :LH
I045651E01
Install the front speed sensor.
Turn the ignition switch off.
Disconnect the front speed sensor connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A10-2 (FR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A10-1 (FR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LH
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A9-2 (FL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A9-1 (FL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BC–61
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
7
INSPECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
Skid Control Sensor Wire:
Sensor Side
Connector “A”
Vehicle Side
Connector “B”
(a) Disconnect the skid control sensor wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A10 ("A"-2) - A10 ("B"-2)
Below 1 Ω
A10 ("A"-2) - A10 ("B"-1)
10 kΩ or higher
A10 ("A"-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A10 :RH
A9 :LH
I044003E01
A10 ("A"-1) - A10 ("B"-1)
Below 1 Ω
A10 ("A"-1) - A10 ("B"-2)
10 kΩ or higher
A10 ("A"-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A9 ("A"-2) - A9 ("B"-2)
Below 1 Ω
A9 ("A"-2) - A9 ("B"-1)
10 kΩ or higher
A9 ("A"-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A9 ("A"-1) - A9 ("B"-1)
Below 1 Ω
A9 ("A"-1) - A9 ("B"-2)
10 kΩ or higher
A9 ("A"-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(See page BC-23).
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
BC
BC–62
8
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - FRONT SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
RH
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
FL-
FR+
Tester Connection
FR-
FL+
Front Speed Sensor Harness Side Connector
Front View:
FR-
S28-3 (FR+) - A10-2 (FR+)
Below 1 Ω
S28-3 (FR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28-17 (FR-) - A10-1 (FR-)
Below 1 Ω
S28-17 (FR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-18 (FL+) - A9-2 (FL+)
Below 1 Ω
S28-18 (FL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28-4 (FL-) - A9-1 (FL-)
Below 1 Ω
S28-4 (FL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A9
A10
FR+
FL-
FL+
NG
BC
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
I045084E02
OK
9
INSPECT MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
Front Speed Sensor Harness Side Connector
Front View:
A9
A10
FR+
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage:
RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A10-2 (FR+) - Body ground
7.5 to 12 V
FL+
I045852E02
LH
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A9-2 (FL+) - Body ground
7.5 to 12 V
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
OK
10
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Drive the vehicle at a speed of approximately 20 mph (32
km/h) or more for 60 seconds or more.
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–63
(c) Check if the same pending DTCs are detected (See
page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output (When troubleshooting in accordance with the
DTC CHART.)
B
DTC is not output (When troubleshooting in accordance with the
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE.)
C
B
END
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
11
REPLACE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Replace the front speed sensor (See page BC-211).
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(See page BC-23).
NEXT
12
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Drive the vehicle at a speed of approximately 20 mph (32
km/h) or more for 60 seconds or more.
(c) Check if the same pending DTCs are detected (See
page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
13
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
(a) Remove the front axle with ABS rotor bearing assembly
(See page AH-6 for 2WD, or AH-13 for 4WD).
BC
BC–64
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Check the sensor rotor.
OK:
No scratches, oil, or foreign matter on the rotors.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after cleaning/
replacement (See page BC-23).
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
CLEAN OR REPLACE FRONT AXLE ABS
ROTOR BEARING ASSEMBLY (SPEED
SENSOR ROTOR)
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–1
VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
• When there is a malfunction in the contact point of the
terminals or installation problems with parts, removal and
installation of the suspected problem parts may return the
system to the normal condition either completely or
temporarily.
• In order to determine the malfunctioning area, be sure to
check the conditions at the time the malfunction occurred,
such as by DTC output and freeze frame data output, and
record it before disconnecting each connector or removing
and installing parts.
• Since the Vehicle Stability Control system may be
influenced by a malfunction in the other systems, be sure
to check for DTCs in the other systems.
• Be sure to remove and install the hydraulic brake booster
and each sensor with the ignition switch off unless
specified in the inspection procedure.
• When removing and installing the hydraulic brake booster
and each sensor, be sure to check that the normal display
is output in test mode inspection and in DTC output
inspection after installing all the parts.
• After replacing the master cylinder solenoid and/or the yaw
rate and acceleration sensor, make sure to perform yaw
rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration (See
page BC-20).
• The CAN communication system is used for data
communication between the skid control ECU (included in
the actuator), the steering angle sensor, and the yaw rate
sensor (the acceleration sensor is included). If there is
trouble in the CAN communication line, the DTC of the
communication line is output.
• If the DTC of the CAN communication line is output, repair
the malfunction in the communication line and
troubleshoot the Vehicle Stability Control system.
• Since the CAN communication line has its own length and
route, it cannot be repaired temporarily with the bypass
wire, etc.
BC
BC–2
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
- MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
(SKID CONTROL ECU)
- BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
REAR
SPEED
SENSOR
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SWITCH
BC
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- ABS SOL FUSE
- STOP FUSE
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
- ABS MTR FUSE
- STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
C119747E04
BC–3
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER
- ABS WARNING LIGHT
- VSC TRAC WARNING LIGHT
- BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
- SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT
- VSC OFF INDICATOR LIGHT (*2)
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
- AUTO LSD INDICATOR LIGHT (*1)
- DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL
INDICATOR LIGHT (*3)
4WD CONTROL SWITCH
- CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
INDICATOR LIGHT (*2)
SKID CONTROL
BUZZER
ECM
CENTER
DIFFERENTIAL
LOCK SWITCH
(*2)
BC
4WD CONTROL ECU
STOP LIGHT
SWITCH
DOWNHILL ASSIST
CONTROL SWITCH (*3)
AUTO LSD SWITCH (*1)
DRIVER SIDE J/B
- ECU-IG FUSE
DLC3
- GAUGE FUSE
YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
- IGN FUSE
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
(*1): 2WD (*2): 4WD (*3): Multi Mode 4WD
C131293E04
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C0210/33 Rear Speed Sensor RH Circuit
DTC
C0215/34 Rear Speed Sensor LH Circuit
DTC
C1238/38
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Rear
Speed Sensor RH
DTC
C1239/39
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Rear
Speed Sensor LH
BC–65
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are
used to control the ABS, BA, TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist and hill-start assist
control systems. This speed sensor contains a sensor IC, which consists of 2 MREs (Magnetic
Resistance Element). The speed sensor rotor, which consists of 48 sets of N and S poles that are
arranged in a circle, is integrated with the inner race of the hub bearing.
To detect the rotation direction, the output waves are used to determine the relationship of the pulses that
are generated by 2 MREs. Upon receiving this signal, the sensor IC outputs a forward or backward wave
to the ECU.
BC
Speed Sensor
MRE A
(+)
Sensor IC
To ECU
MRE B
(-)
Speed Sensor Rotor
(Bearing Inner Race)
Low speed
High speed
2.6 V
1.4 V
0.7 V
Backward
Forward
I042838E01
BC–66
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C0210/33
C0215/34
When any of the following conditions is detected:
1. At a vehicle speed of 6 mph (10 km/h) or more,
pulses are not input for 1 second.
2. Momentary interruption of the speed sensor signal
occurs at least 255 times when switching the ignition
switch ON and OFF.
3. Continuous noise occurs in speed sensor signals at
a vehicle speed of 12 mph (20 km/h) or more.
4. Speed sensor signal circuit is open for 0.12 seconds
or more.
5. 3 of the wheel sensors detect normal reversing
signals, and the other wheel sensor detects malfunction
signals 75 times with IG ON while reversing at 3 km/h.
6. Rotating direction of each wheel changes 7 times
within 0.006 seconds with IG ON while driving at 10 km/
h or more.
7. Rotating direction of one of the wheels is not the
same as that of the other wheels for 1 second while
driving at 30 km/h or more.
8. Reversing signal is output for 1 second or more while
driving at 100 km/h or more.
9. Rotating direction of one of the wheels is not
detected normally, and the rotating direction of each of
the other wheels is not the same for 1 second while
driving at 30 km/h or more.
•
•
•
•
•
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Speed sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Master cylinder solenoid
C1238/38
C1239/39
Continuous noise occurs in speed sensor signals when
vehicle speed is 12 mph (20 km/h) or more for 5
seconds or more.
•
•
•
•
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Speed sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Master cylinder solenoid
HINT:
• DTC C0210/33 and C1238/38 are for the right rear speed sensor.
• DTC C0215/34 and C1239/39 are for the left rear speed sensor.
BC–67
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Rear Speed Sensor RH
Shielded
5
1
2
S28
RR+
19
S28
RR-
20
S28
RL+
6
S28
RL-
Shielded
Rear Speed Sensor LH
1
2
BC
C132911E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION OF REAR
SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN RR
Speed sensor open detection
(RR)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN RL
Speed sensor open detection
(RL)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
(d) Check for any momentary interruption in the wire
harness and connector corresponding to a DTC (See
page BC-18).
OK:
There are no momentary interruptions.
BC–68
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
Perform the above inspection before removing the
sensor and connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT)
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (REAR SPEED SENSOR)
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
WHEEL SPD RR
Wheel speed sensor (RR)
reading /Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h),
Max.: 202 mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD RL
Wheel speed sensor (RL) reading
/Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h), Max.: 202
mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
(a) Check that there is no difference between the speed
value output from the speed sensor displayed on the
intelligent tester and the speed value displayed on the
speedometer when driving the vehicle.
OK:
The speed value output from the speed sensor
displayed on the intelligent tester is the same as
the actual vehicle speed.
BC
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
PERFORM TEST MODE (SIGNAL CHECK)
(a) Check if test mode (signal check) DTCs are detected.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Test mode (signal check) DTC is output
A
Test mode (signal check) DTC is not output
B
B
A
Go to step 10
BC–69
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a) Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation nut is tightened properly.
There is no clearance between the sensor and the
rear axle.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement (See
page BC-23).
8.3 N*m
(85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
No clearance
OK
NG
I044006E04
NG
INSTALL REAR SPEED SENSOR
CORRECTLY
OK
5
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR TIP
(a) Remove the rear speed sensor (See page BC-213).
(b) Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign matter on the sensor tip.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after cleaning/
replacement (See page BC-23).
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE REAR SPEED
SENSOR
OK
6
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Rear Speed Sensor:
2
1
A41 :RH
A40 :LH
I045651E03
Install the rear speed sensor.
Turn the ignition switch off.
Disconnect the rear speed sensor connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A41-2 (RR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A41-1 (RR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A40-2 (RL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A40-1 (RL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR
BC
BC–70
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
7
INSPECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
(a) Disconnect the skid control sensor wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
RH
Skid Control Sensor Wire:
Sensor Side
Connector “A”:
Vehicle Side
Connector “B”:
A41 :RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A40 :LH
A41 ("A"-2) - A41 ("B"-4)
Below 1 Ω
A41 ("A"-2) - A41 ("B"-3)
10 kΩ or higher
A41 ("A"-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I044004E05
A41 ("A"-1) - A41 ("B"-3)
Below 1 Ω
A41 ("A"-1) - A41 ("B"-4)
10 kΩ or higher
A41 ("A"-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LH
Tester Connection
BC
Specified Condition
A40 ("A"-2) - A40 ("B"-2)
Below 1 Ω
A40 ("A"-2) - A40 ("B"-1)
10 kΩ or higher
A40 ("A"-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A40 ("A"-1) - A40 ("B"-1)
Below 1 Ω
A40 ("A"-1) - A40 ("B"-2)
10 kΩ or higher
A40 ("A"-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(See page BC-23).
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
BC–71
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - REAR SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
RH
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector front view)
S28
RR+
RL-
Tester Connection
RR-
RL+
(harness side connector front view)
A41 :RH
RL-
RL+
S28-5 (RR+) - A41 (A-4) (RR+)
Below 1 Ω
S28-5 (RR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28-19 (RR-) - A41 (A-3) (RR-)
Below 1 Ω
S28-19 (RR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LH
Rear Speed Sensor
A40 :LH
Specified Condition
RR-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-20 (RL+) - A40 (A-2) (RL+)
Below 1 Ω
S28-20 (RL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28-6 (RL-) - A40 (A-1) (RL-)
Below 1 Ω
S28-6 (RL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
RR+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
F049552E18
OK
9
INSPECT MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage:
RH
Rear Speed Sensor
(harness side connector front view)
A40 :LH
A41 :RH
RL+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A41 (A-4) (RR+) - Body ground
7.5 to 12 V
RR+
C110680E19
LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A40 (A-2) (RL+) - Body ground
7.5 to 12 V
NG
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
OK
10
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Drive the vehicle at a speed of approximately 20 mph (32
km/h) or more for 60 seconds or more.
BC
BC–72
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Check if the same pending DTCs are detected (See
page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output (When troubleshooting in accordance with the
DTC CHART.)
B
DTC is not output (When troubleshooting in accordance with the
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE.)
C
B
END
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
11
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR
(a) Replace the rear speed sensor (See page BC-213).
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(See page BC-23).
BC
NEXT
12
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Drive the vehicle at a speed of approximately 20 mph (32
km/h) or more for 60 seconds or more.
(c) Check if the same pending DTCs are detected (See
page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
13
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
(a) Remove the rear axle bearing assembly (See page AH23).
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–73
(b) Check the sensor rotor.
OK:
No scratches, oil, or foreign matter on the rotors.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after cleaning/
replacement (See page BC-23).
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE REAR AXLE BEARING
ASSEMBLY (SPEED SENSOR ROTOR)
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–74
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C0226/21 SFR Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C0236/22 SFL Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C0246/23 SRR Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C0256/24 SRL Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C1225/25 SMC Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C1226/26 SPC Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C1227/27 SRC Solenoid Circuit
DTC
C1228/28 STR Solenoid Circuit
DESCRIPTION
BC
The solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on the
wheel cylinders, thus controlling braking force.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C0226/21
Open or short circuit in SFRH or SFRR circuit continues
for 0.05 seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SFRH or SFRR circuit
C0236/22
Open or short circuit in SFLH or SFLR circuit continues
for 0.05 seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SFLH or SFLR circuit
C0246/23
Open or short circuit in SRRH or SRRR circuit
continues for 0.05 seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SRRH or SRRR circuit
C0256/24
Open or short circuit in SRLH or SRLR circuit continues
for 0.05 seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SRLH or SRLR circuit
C1225/25
Open or short circuit in SMCF circuit continues for 0.05
seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SMCF circuit
C1226/26
Open or short circuit in SREA circuit continues for 0.05
seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SREA circuit
C1227/27
Open or short circuit in SREC circuit continues for 0.05
seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
SREC circuit
C1228/28
Open or short circuit in STR circuit continues for 0.05
seconds or more.
•
•
Master cylinder solenoid
STR circuit
BC–75
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
ABS SOL
1
2
S28
31
Solenoid Relay
+BS
STR
SREC
SFRH
SFLH
BC
SRRH
SRLH
SFRR
S28
GND1
SFLR
1
SRRR
S28
GND2
32
S29
Battery
SRLR
GND3
SREA
4
SMCF
C132912E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–76
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
RECONFIRM DTC
HINT:
These codes are detected when a problem is determined in
the master cylinder solenoid.
The solenoid circuit is in the master cylinder solenoid.
Therefore, solenoid circuit inspection and solenoid unit
inspection cannot be performed. Be sure to check if any DTC
is output before replacing the master cylinder solenoid.
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTCs are detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
BC
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–77
Open or Short Circuit in ABS Solenoid Relay
Circuit
DTC
C0278/11
DTC
C0279/12 Short to B+ in ABS Solenoid Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The ABS solenoid relay is built in the master cylinder solenoid.
This relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. If the initial check is OK, after the ignition switch is turned
to the ON position, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C0278/11
When either of the following conditions is detected:
1. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
0.2 seconds.
(a) IG voltage is between 9.5 V and 17 V.
(b) Relay contact is open when the relay is ON
2. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
0.2 seconds.
(a) IG voltage is 9.5 V or less when the relay is ON.
(b) Relay contact remains open.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
ABS SOL fuse
ABS solenoid relay
ABS solenoid relay circuit
Master cylinder solenoid
C0279/12
The following condition continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
• Relay contact is closed immediately after turning IG
switch to the ON position when the relay is OFF.
•
•
•
•
ABS SOL fuse
ABS solenoid relay
ABS solenoid relay circuit
Master cylinder solenoid
BC
BC–78
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
ABS SOL
1
2
S28
31
Solenoid Relay
+BS
STR
SREC
SFRH
SFLH
BC
SRRH
SRLH
SFRR
S28
GND1
SFLR
1
SRRR
S28
GND2
32
S29
Battery
SRLR
GND3
SREA
4
SMCF
C132912E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–79
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
1
INSPECT ABS SOL FUSE
(a) Remove the ABS SOL fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Check the ABS SOL fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE ABS SOL FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (+BS TERMINAL)
(a) Install the ABS SOL fuse.
(b) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness
Side Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-31 (+BS) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
+BS
C121700E96
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (+BS CIRCUIT)
BC
BC–80
3
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S28-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND1
GND2
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
GND3
S29
BC
C124799E12
OK
4
RECONFIRM DTC
HINT:
These codes are detected when a problem is determined in
the master cylinder solenoid.
The ABS solenoid relay is in the master cylinder solenoid.
Therefore, solenoid relay circuit inspection and relay unit
inspection cannot be performed. Be sure to check if any DTC
is output before replacing the master cylinder solenoid.
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTCs are detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
BC–81
C1201/51 Engine Control System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
If trouble occurs in the engine control system, the ECM transmits the abnormality to the skid control ECU.
The skid control ECU sets this DTC and prohibits TRAC and VSC control.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1201/51
Malfunction signal is received from ECM.
Trouble Area
Engine control system
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC (FOR ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM)
(a) Check if the engine control system DTC is output (See
page ES-31 for 1GR-FE, or ES-35 for 2UZ-FE).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
REPLACE ECM
INSPECT ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
BC
BC–82
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1202/52
Brake Fluid Level Low / Open Circuit in Brake
Fluid Level Warning Switch Circuit
DTC
C1202/58
Brake Fluid Level Low / Open Circuit in Brake
Fluid Level Warning Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level warning switch sends the appropriate signal to the skid control ECU when the brake
fluid level drops.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1202/52
C1202/58
BC
Trouble Area
When either of the following conditions is detected:
1. With ECU terminal IG1 voltage at 9.5 V to 17.2 V,
an open in the brake fluid level warning switch
circuit continues for 2 seconds or more.
2. Fluid level of the reservoir tank is LOW for 4
seconds or 40 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned ON, of for 7 seconds during pump motor
operation.
•
•
•
Brake fluid level
Brake fluid level warning switch
Brake fluid level warning switch circuit
HINT:
If the code (C1202/52) is output, the following situations will occur:
• The VSC TRAC and BRAKE warning lights, and the VSC OFF indicator light will come on.
• Control of all systems other than ABS and EBD is canceled.
If the code (C1202/58) is output, the following situations will occur:
• The ABS, VSC TRAC, and BRAKE warning lights, and the SLIP and VSC OFF indicator lights will
come on.
• Control of all systems other than EBD is canceled.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
ECU-IG
from Ignition Switch
46
S28
IG1
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
41
1
2
S28
LBL
C132913E03
BC–83
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
HINT:
When C1241/41 is output together with C1202/52 or C1202/58, inspect and repair the trouble areas
indicated by C1241/41 first.
1
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Depress the brake pedal 20 times or more (until the
pedal reaction feels light and pedal stroke becomes
longer).
(c) Check the amount of fluid in the brake reservoir.
HINT:
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position,
brake fluid is sent to the accumulator and the fluid level
decreases by approximately 5 mm from the level when
the ignition switch is off (normal).
NOTICE:
Do not move the wheels with the ignition switch off.
OK:
Brake fluid level is proper.
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR BRAKE FLUID
LEAKAGE
OK
2
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the brake fluid level warning switch
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
HINT:
• A float is placed inside the reservoir. Its position can
be changed by increasing/decreasing the level of
brake fluid.
• The warning switch is switched ON/OFF at +- 5mm
from the MIN level.
Standard resistance
B14
+-5mm
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B14-1 - B14-2
Float UP (Switch OFF)
1.9 to 2.1 kΩ
B14-1 - B14-2
Float DOWN (Switch
ON)
Below 1 Ω
F052341E04
HINT:
If there is no problem after finishing the above check,
adjust the brake fluid level to the MAX level.
NG
REPLACE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR SUB-ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–84
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH - SKID
CONTROL ECU)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
LBL
Brake Fluid Level Warming Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-41 (LBL) - B14-2
Below 1 Ω
S28-41 (LBL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B14-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B14
BC
I045330E03
OK
4
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTCs are detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC–85
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1203/53 ECM Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The circuit is used to send TRAC and VSC control information from the skid control ECU to the ECM, and
engine control information from the ECM to the skid control ECU via the CAN communication system.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Engine drive source and destination variation that are
sent from the ECM do not match the one of the ECU.
C1203/53
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
ECM
CANH
CANL
11
33
S28
CANH
BC
25
34
S28
CANL
C132914E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC (FOR ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM)
(a) Check if the engine control system DTC is output (See
page ES-31 for 1GR-FE, or ES-35 for 2UZ-FE).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
REPLACE ECM
INSPECT ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–86
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1210/36
Zero Point Calibration of Yaw Rate Sensor
Undone
DTC
C1336/39
Zero Point Calibration of Acceleration Sensor
Undone
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU receives signals from the yaw rate and acceleration sensor via the CAN
communication system.
The yaw rate sensor has a built-in acceleration sensor.
If there is trouble in the bus lines between the yaw rate and acceleration sensor and the CAN
communication system, the DTC U0123/62 (yaw rate sensor communication trouble) and U0124/95
(acceleration sensor communication trouble) are output.
These DTCs are also output when the calibration has not been completed.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1210/36
When either of the following conditions is detected:
1. When battery terminal was connected, shift lever
was moved to non-P position within 15 seconds
after ECU terminal IG1 became ON first.
2. When the yaw rate sensor zero point recorded in
ECU is deleted.
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Zero point calibration undone
Park/Neutral position switch (P) circuit
C1336/39
When either of the following conditions is detected:
1. In test mode, shift lever is shifted to non-P position
2 seconds after ECU terminal IG1 is turned ON
first.
2. When acceleration sensor zero point recorded in
ECU is deleted.
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Zero point calibration undone
Park/Neutral position switch (P) circuit
BC
HINT:
If these codes (C1210/36 and/or C1336/39) are output, the following situations will occur.
• The VSC TRAC warning light and the VSC OFF and SLIP indicator lights will come on.
• Control of all systems other than ABS, EBD, and BA is canceled.
BC–87
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Yaw Rate and
Acceleration Sensor
Master Cylinder Solenoid
11
CANH
S28
3
CANH
25
CANL
S28
2
CANL
Park/Neutral Position Switch
14
PL
S28
6
P
BC
C132915E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
HINT:
When U0073/94, U0100/65, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 is output together with C1210/36 or
C1336/39, inspect and repair the trouble areas indicated by U0073/94, U0100/65, U0123/62, U0124/95 or
U0126/63 first.
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
NEXT
2
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTCs are detected. (See page BC39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
BC–88
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
The DTCs are recorded because zero point calibration
has not been completed.
End the procedure since the same DTCs are not
recorded after completion of the zero point calibration.
B
END
A
3
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a) Check that the yaw rate and acceleration sensor has
been installed properly.
OK:
The sensor should be tightened to the specified
torque.
The sensor should not be tilted.
NG
INSTALL YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION
SENSOR CORRECTLY
OK
BC
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
P
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and Park/
Neutral position switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
NG
Park/Neutral Position Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
P1
PL
F052381E04
OK
Specified Condition
S28-14 (P) - P1-6 (PL)
Below 1 Ω
S28-14 (P) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–89
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
5
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Park/Neutral Position Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
2 - 6, 4 - 5
P
Below 1 Ω
P1
C124790E05
NG
1-2
R
Below 1 Ω
2 - 9, 4 - 5
N
Below 1 Ω
2-7
D, 4
Below 1 Ω
2-3
3
Below 1 Ω
2-8
2, L
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
OK
6
REPLACE YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
(a) Replace the yaw rate and acceleration sensor (See page
BC-91).
NEXT
7
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
NEXT
8
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTCs are detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC
BC–90
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1223/43 ABS Control System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
C1223/43
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ABS control system is abnormal
ABS control system
HINT:
• This DTC is output when the VSC system detects a malfunction in the ABS system.
• When DTC C1223/43 is memorized, there is no malfunction in the skid control ECU.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC (FOR ABS SYSTEM)
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if DTC is recorded.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
BC
B
END
A
REPAIR REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTC
BC–91
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1231/31 Steering Angle Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1290/66 Steering Angle Sensor Zero Point Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The steering angle sensor signal is sent to the skid control ECU through the CAN communication system.
When there is a malfunction in the communication system, it will be detected by the diagnosis function.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1231/31
When ECU IG1 terminal voltage is 9.5 V or more, the
steering angle sensor malfunction signal is received.
•
•
•
•
Steering angle sensor
Steering angle sensor circuit
Steering angle sensor power supply
CAN communication system
C1290/66
The steering angle sensor zero point calibration
position vastly differs from the recorded value.
Steering angle sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Angle Sensor
CANL
Master Cylinder Solenoid
11
CANH
BC
25
S28
CANL
11
S28
CANH
3
ECU-B
BAT
9
2
1
from Battery
ECU-IG
IG1
ESS
1
from Ignition Switch
2
C132916E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
HINT:
• When U0073/94, U0100/65, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 is output together with C1231/31and
C1290/66, inspect and repair the trouble areas indicated by U0073/94, U0100/65, U0123/62, U0124/
95 or U0126/63 first.
BC–92
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
• When the speed sensor or the yaw rate and acceleration sensor has trouble, DTCs of the steering
angle sensor may be output even when the steering angle sensor is normal. When DTCs of the speed
sensor (C0200/31, C0205/32, C0210/33, C0215/34, C1235/35, C1236/36, C1238/38, C1239/39) or
yaw rate and acceleration sensor (C1232/32, C1234/34, C1243/43, C1244/44, C1245/45, C1381/97)
are output together with other DTCs of the steering angle sensor, inspect and repair the speed sensor
and yaw rate and acceleration sensor first, and then inspect and repair the steering angle sensor.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
STEERING ANG
Steering angle sensor/ Min.: 1152 deg/s, Max.: 1150.875 deg/s
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
-
(d) Check that the steering wheel turning angle value of the
steering angle sensor displayed on the intelligent tester
changes when turning the steering wheel.
OK:
Steering angle sensor value changes.
BC
Result
Condition
Proceed to
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with DTC CHART)
A
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
NG
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
Go to step 3
A
2
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Drive the vehicle at a speed of approximately 6 mph (10
km/h) or more for 10 seconds or more.
(c) Check if the same pending DTCs are detected (See
page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
BC–93
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
3
INSPECT STEERING ANGLE SENSOR (POWER SOURCE AND GROUND TERMINAL)
Steering Angle Sensor Harness View:
ESS
S11
IG1
BAT
I046350E02
(a) Remove the steering wheel and the column cover lower.
(b) Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S11-1 (IG1) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
S11-9 (BAT) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S11-2 (ESS) - Body
ground
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
• When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC
CHART, check DTCs before replacing the steering
angle sensor (See page BC-39).
• When troubleshooting in accordance with the
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE, be sure to follow the
table before replacing the steering angle sensor (See
page BC-33).
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE OR
GROUND CIRCUIT)
BC
BC–94
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1232/32 Stuck in Deceleration Sensor
DTC
C1234/34 Yaw Rate Sensor Malfunction
DTC
C1243/43 Acceleration Sensor Stuck Malfunction
DTC
C1244/44 Open or Short in Deceleration Sensor Circuit
DTC
C1245/45 Acceleration Sensor Output Malfunction
DTC
C1381/97
Yaw Rate and / or Acceleration Sensor Power
Supply Voltage Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
BC
The skid control ECU receives signals from the yaw rate and acceleration sensor via the CAN
communication system.
The yaw rate sensor has a built-in acceleration sensor.
If there is trouble in the bus lines between the yaw rate and acceleration sensor and the CAN
communication system, the DTC U0123/62 (yaw rate sensor communication trouble) and U0124/95
(acceleration sensor communication trouble) are output.
These DTCs are also output when the calibration has not been completed.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1232/32
At a vehicle speed of 6 mph (10 km/h) or more, the
fluctuation range of the signal from either GL1 or GL2 is
under 80 mV and the other is above 1.9 V for 30
seconds or more.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor circuit
CAN communication system
C1234/34
Sensor malfunction signal is received from yaw rate
sensor.
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor circuit
CAN communication system
C1243/43
The following condition repeats 16 times.
• GL1 and GL2 do not change by more than 2LSB
when the vehicle decelerates from 19 mph (30 km/
h) to 0 mph (0 km/h).
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor circuit
CAN communication system
C1244/44
When either of the following conditions is detected:
1. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
60 seconds.
• Vehicle is stopped.
• Difference between GL1 and GL2 does not drop
below 0.4 G once it reaches 0.6 G or more.
2. Data malfunction signal is received from acceleration
sensor.
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor circuit
CAN communication system
C1245/45
The following condition continues for at least 60
seconds.
• Difference between the values calculated from
acceleration sensor value and vehicle speed
exceeds 0.35 G.
•
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor circuit
CAN communication system
C1381/97
acceleration sensor power source malfunction signal is
received for at least 10 seconds at a speed of more
than 2 mph (3 km/h).
•
•
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor power source
circuit
CAN communication system
•
BC–95
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Yaw Rate and
Acceleration Sensor
Master Cylinder Solenoid
CANL
2
CANH
25
S28
CANL
11
S28
CANH
3
ECU-IG
IG
from Ignition Switch
5
GND
1
BC
C132917E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the yaw rate and acceleration sensor, perform zero point calibration (See page
BC-20).
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
Turn the ignition switch off.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check if the DTCs (U0073/94, U0123/62, C1210/36 and/
or C1336/39) are detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC U0073/94, U0123/62, C1210/36 and/or C1336/39 are not
output
A
DTC U0073/94 and/or U0123/62 are output
B
DTC C1210/36 and/or C1336/39 are output
C
B
INSPECT CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
C
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
BC–96
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
A
2
INSPECT YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR (IG AND GND TERMINAL)
Yaw Rate and Acceleration Sensor Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Y1
GND
IG
F045082E24
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate and acceleration sensor
connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-5 (IG) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-1 (GND) - Body
ground
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
Result
Condition
BC
Proceed to
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC CHART)
A
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
NG
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IG OR GND CIRCUIT)
A
REPLACE YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
BC–97
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1241/41 Low Battery Positive Voltage
DESCRIPTION
If the voltage supplied to the IG1 terminal is not within the DTC detection threshold due to malfunctions in
such as the battery and alternator circuit, this DTC is stored.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1241/41
When either of the following conditions is detected:
1. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
10 seconds.
• Vehicle speed is more than 2 mph (3 km/m).
• IG1 terminal voltage is less than 9.5 V.
2. All of the following conditions continue for at least 0.2
seconds.
• Solenoid relay remains ON.
• IG1 terminal voltage is less than 9.5 V.
• Relay contact is open.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Battery
ECU-IG fuse
Charging system
Power source circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
BC
Ignition Switch
ECU-IG
2
AM1
IG1
4
46
S28
IG1
1
2
AM1
S28
GND1
1
32
2
S28
GND2
4
S29
GND3
ALT
1
Battery
C132918E01
BC–98
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT ECU-IG FUSE
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Check the ECU-IG fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
BC
REPLACE ECU-IG FUSE
OK
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (IG1 POWER SUPPLY)
(a) Install the ECU-IG fuse.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(d) Start the engine.
(e) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
IG VOLTAGE
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
ECU-IG power supply voltage /
TOO LOW / NORMAL / TOO
HIGH
(f)
TOO LOW: 9.5 V or less
NORMAL: 9.5 V or 14.0 V
TOO HIGH: 14.0 V or more
Diagnostic Note
-
Measure the voltage output from the ECU displayed on
the intelligent tester.
OK:
"Normal" is displayed.
NG
OK
Normal Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IG1 CIRCUIT)
BC–99
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (IG1 TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Install the ECU-IG fuse.
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-46 (IG1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
S28
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IG1 CIRCUIT)
IG1
C121700E79
OK
5
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S28-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND1
BC
GND2
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
GND3
S29
C124799E13
OK
6
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
BC–100
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output (When troubleshooting in accordance with the
DTC CHART)
B
DTC is not output (When troubleshooting in accordance with the
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
C
B
END
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–19
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
1.
Intelligent Tester
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HINT:
A momentary interruption (open circuit) in the connectors
and/or wire harness between the sensors and ECUs can
be detected in the ECU data monitor function of the
intelligent tester.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off and connect the
intelligent tester to the DLC3.
DLC3
I042828E01
(b) Turn the ignition switch on. Follow the on-screen
directions on the intelligent tester to display the
DATA LIST and select areas where momentary
interruption should be monitored.
Harness Signal:
OK
Momentary
interruption
1 sec. 1 sec. 1 sec.
Intelligent Tester Display:
OPN DET
NORMAL
C106657E11
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN FR
Speed sensor open detection
(FR) / OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN FL
Speed sensor open detection
(FL) / OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN RR
Speed sensor open detection
(RR) / OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN RL
Speed sensor open detection
(RL) / OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
HINT:
• A momentary interruption (open circuit) cannot
be detected for 3 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned on (initial check).
BC
BC–20
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
• If the intelligent tester status remains on, check
the continuity between the ECU and the sensors,
or between ECUs.
• The OPN DET display on the intelligent tester
remains on for 1 second after the harness signal
changes from momentary interruption (open
circuit) to normal condition.
(c) While observing the screen, gently jiggle the
connector or wire harness between the ECU and
sensors, or between ECUs.
Result:
OPN DET display does not change.
HINT:
The connector and/or wire harness will be in
momentary interruption (open circuit) if the display
changes. Repair or replace connector and/or wire
harness as one of them is faulty.
F047126
BC
BC–101
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1242/42 IG2 Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
If there is a problem with the master cylinder solenoid power supply circuit, the skid control ECU outputs
DTCs and prohibits operation under the fail safe function.
If the voltage supplied to the IG2 terminal is not within the DTC detection threshold due to malfunctions in
such as the battery and alternator circuit, this DTC is stored.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1242/42
Vehicle speed is 1.9 mph (3 km/h) or more and voltage
of ECU IG2 terminal remains at below 6.5 V for more
than 7 seconds.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Battery
IGN fuse
IC regulator
Power source circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Ignition Switch
IGN
7
AM2
IG2
6
BC
1
S29
IG2
1
S28
2
GND1
32
AM2
S28
GND2
1
4
S29
GND3
Battery
C132919E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–102
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT IGN FUSE
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Check the IGN fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE IGN FUSE
OK
BC
3
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (IG2 TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Install the IGN fuse.
Disconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
S29
NG
IG2
C124800E03
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S29-1 (IG2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IG2 CIRCUIT)
BC–103
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S28-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND1
GND2
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
GND3
S29
BC
C124799E14
OK
5
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC–104
DTC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
C1246/46 Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The master cylinder pressure sensor is connected to the skid control ECU in the master cylinder solenoid.
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
from Battery
BC
from
Stop Light Switch
to Body Ground
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
IG1
VM/C1
(VCM)
VC
STP
PM/C1
(PMC)
VOUT
GND
M/C1 GND
GND
VM/C1 (VCM): Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor Power Supply Output
PM/C1 (PMC ): Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor Signal Input
M/C1 GND: Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor Ground
C124773E06
BC–105
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1246/46
When any of the following conditions is detected:
1. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
30 seconds.
• Vehicle speed is more than 4 mph (7 km/h).
• PMC terminal voltage does not change by more
than 0.005 V once it exceeds 0.86 V.
2. PMC terminal receives interference at least 7 times
within 5 seconds.
3. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
1.2 seconds.
• Stop light switch is OFF.
• PMC terminal voltage is more than 0.86 V or less
than 0.3 V.
4. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
1.2 seconds.
• IG1 terminal voltage is between 9.5 and 17 V.
• VCM terminal voltage is not between 4.4 and 5.6 V.
5. Both of the following conditions continue for at least
1.2 seconds.
• VCM terminal voltage is between 4.4 and 5.6 V.
• PMC terminal voltage is not between 0.14 and 4.85
V.
•
•
•
•
Master cylinder pressure sensor
Master cylinder pressure sensor circuit
Stop light switch circuit
Master cylinder solenoid
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
•
MAS CYL PRESS 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
Diagnostic Note
When brake pedal is
released: 0.3 to 0.9 V
When stop light is turned on:
0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
(d) Check that the master cylinder pressure value of the
master cylinder pressure sensor displayed on the
intelligent tester changes when depressing the brake
pedal.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Master cylinder pressure sensor value does not change
A
Master cylinder pressure sensor value changes but it is not
normal
B
Master cylinder pressure sensor value becomes normal
C
A
C
B
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
Go to step 4
BC
BC–106
2
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL AND STOP LIGHT SWITCH INSTALLATION
(a) Check the brake pedal height.
(b) Check the stop light switch installation.
OK:
The brake pedal and stop light switch are normal.
NG
ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL AND/OR STOP
LIGHT SWITCH
OK
3
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (STP TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-7 (STP) - Body
ground
Stop light switch ON
(Brake pedal
depressed)
8 to 14 V
S28-7 (STP) - Body
ground
Stop light switch OFF
(Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S28
BC
NG
STP
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STP CIRCUIT)
C121700E80
OK
4
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC–210
BRAKE CONTROL – FRONT SPEED SENSOR
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
BC
SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
C119747E01
BRAKE CONTROL – FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BC–211
REMOVAL
HINT:
Replacement of RH side is same as that of LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
F044160
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (5 mm), remove the bolt
and front speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
SST 99999-60011
NOTICE:
• Do not stick and foreign matter on the sensor
tip.
• Do not let the foreign matter into the sensor
installation hole.
F043112
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (5 mm), install the front
speed sensor with the bolt to the steering knuckle.
SST 99999-60011
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure the sensor tip is clean.
F043112
(b) Connect the speed sensor connector.
F044160
2.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 110 N*m (1.122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
3.
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
BC–107
C1249/49 Open in Stop Light Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU inputs the stop light switch signal and detects the status of brake operation.
The skid control ECU has an open detection circuit.
If an open in the stop light switch input line or GND side stop light circuit is detected when the stop light
switch is off, this DTC is output.
DTC No.
C1249/49
DTC Detection Condition
ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 to 17.0 V, ABS is in
non-operation, and an open in stop light switch circuit
continues for 0.3 seconds or more.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
Rear combination light (stop light) assembly
BC
BC–108
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Stop Light Switch
45
S28
1
2
STP2
4
7
5
BC
3
1
2
S28
STP
16
S28
STPO
Stop Light Operation
(STOP LP CTRL)
2
STOP
IG1
1
Rear Combination Light LH
6
STOP
1
from Ignition Switch
Rear Combination Light RH
from Battery
6
STOP
1
to High Mounted
Stop Light
C132920E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–109
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
1
CHECK STOP LIGHT SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Check that the stop light comes on when the brake pedal
is depressed, and goes off when the brake pedal is
released.
OK:
Stop light switch function is normal.
HINT:
Check the stop light bulb as it may have burnt out.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (STP TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
STP
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-7 (STP) - Body
ground
Stop light switch ON
(Brake pedal
depressed)
8 to 14 V
S28-7 (STP) - Body
ground
Stop light switch OFF
(Brake pedal released)
Below 1.5 V
C121700E81
Result
Condition
Proceed to
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC CHART)
A
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
NG
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STP CIRCUIT)
A
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
BC
BC–110
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
4
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY (POWER SOURCE TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the stop light switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Stop Light Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
BC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S12-2 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
S12
NG
I042363E23
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
OK
5
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
2
1
Pushed in
4
3
S12
C124796E06
OK
Specified Condition
S12-1 - S12-2
Switch pin free
Below 1 Ω
S12-1 - S12-2
Switch pin pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Free
Condition
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
BC–111
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
6
INSPECT STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
(a) Remove the stop light operation relay.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
E068810
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - STOP LIGHT SWITCH)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Stop Light Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
S28-7 (STP) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
• When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC
CHART, check DTCs before replacing the master
cylinder solenoid (See page BC-39).
• When troubleshooting in accordance with the
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE, be sure to follow the
table before replacing the master cylinder solenoid
(See page BC-33).
STP
S12
Tester Connection
S28-7 (STP) - S12-1
NG
C121702E08
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC
BC–112
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1251/51 Open in Pump Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The motor relay (semiconductor relay) is built in the master cylinder solenoid and drives the pump motor
based on a signal from the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1251/51
Trouble Area
Open in motor system circuit (motor input circuit)
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
2
BC
S28
ABS MTR
1
2
+BM1
Motor Relay
2
+BM2
S29
1
S28
32
S28
4
S29
GND1
GND2
GND3
M+1
M+2
Battery
MT-
MT+
Pump Motor
C132922E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
HINT:
Remove the hydraulic brake booster before the inspection (See page BR-25).
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
1
BC–113
CHECK CONNECTION OF PUMP MOTOR WIRE HARNESS (MT+ / MT-)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 plugs from the
hydraulic brake booster assembly (See page BR-25).
(b) Check the tightening torque of the 2 screws which
tighten the wire harness connecting the hydraulic brake
booster assembly and the brake booster pump (See
page BR-25).
OK:
The harness is tightened to the specific torque.
Torque: 2.9 N*m (30 kgf*cm, 26 in.*lbf)
NG
RETIGHTEN SCREWS UP
OK
2
CHECK RESISTANCE OF PUMP MOTOR WIRE HARNESS (MT+ / MT-)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 screws and pull the
wire harness from the hydraulic brake booster assembly
(See page BR-25).
(b) Measure the resistance between the red wire (MT+) and
the black wire (MT-).
Standard resistance:
2Ω
Rear Wire
(MT+)
NG
Black Wire (MT-)
F051186E01
REPLACE BRAKE BOOSTER WITH
ACCUMULATOR PUMP ASSEMBLY
OK
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Reassemble the hydraulic brake booster assembly (See
page BR-31).
(b) Install the hydraulic brake booster assembly (See page
BR-35).
(c) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(d) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC
BC–114
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
Brake Booster Pump Motor on Time Abnormally Long
C1252/52
DESCRIPTION
The motor relay (semiconductor relay) is built in the master cylinder solenoid and drivers the pump motor
based on a signal from the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1252/52
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Motor operates for 5 minutes or more.
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor circuit
Accumulator pressure sensor
HINT:
The pump motor continues operation for the first 3 minutes, then repeats start and stop.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
BC
Skid Control ECU
2
S28
ABS MTR
1
2
+BM1
Motor Relay
2
+BM2
S29
1
S28
32
S28
4
S29
GND1
GND2
GND3
M+1
M+2
Battery
MT-
MT+
Pump Motor
C132922E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–115
HINT:
When C1253/53, C1254/54, or C1256/56 is output together with C1252/52, inspect and repair the trouble
area indicated by C1253/53, C1254/54, or C1256/56 first.
1
CHECK PUMP MOTOR OPERATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch off.
Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check how the pump motor operates.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Pump motor does not operate
A
Pump motor operates continuously, and does not stop
B
Pump motor operates intermittently
C
Pump motor operates, then stops
D
B
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
AND BRAKE BOOSTER WITH
ACCUMULATOR PUMP ASSEMBLY
C
Go to step 4
D
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PUMP MOTOR WIRE HARNESS (MT+ / MT-)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 plugs from the
hydraulic brake booster assembly (See page BR-25).
(b) Check the tightening torque of the 2 screws which
tighten the wire harness connecting the hydraulic brake
booster assembly and the brake booster pump (See
page BR-25).
OK:
The harness is tightened to the specific torque.
Torque: 2.9 N*m (30 kgf*cm, 26 in.*lbf)
NG
OK
RETIGHTEN SCREWS UP
BC
BC–116
3
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK RESISTANCE OF PUMP MOTOR WIRE HARNESS (MT+ / MT-)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 screws and pull the
wire harness from the hydraulic brake booster assembly
(See page BR-25).
(b) Measure the resistance between the red wire (MT+) and
the black wire (MT-).
Standard resistance:
2Ω
Rear Wire
(MT+)
NG
Black Wire (MT-)
F051186E01
REPLACE BRAKE BOOSTER WITH
ACCUMULATOR PUMP ASSEMBLY
OK
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
BC
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Item
ACC PRESS
Accumulator pressure sensor
reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
If the value is constant regardless
of pump operation, accumulator
pressure sensor malfunction is
suspected.
3.58 to 5 V
(d) Check the accumulator output value.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Output value is within the "Normal Condition" range
A
Output value is out of the "Normal Condition" range
B
Output value is constant regardless of pump operation
C
B
REPLACE HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
C
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
AND BRAKE BOOSTER WITH
ACCUMULATOR PUMP ASSEMBLY
A
5
RECONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
Turn the ignition switch off.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Wait for more than 5 minutes.
Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–117
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
REPLACE BRAKE BOOSTER WITH
ACCUMULATOR PUMP ASSEMBLY
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID AND BRAKE BOOSTER WITH ACCUMULATOR PUMP
ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–118
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1253/53 Hydro Booster Pump Motor Relay Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The motor relay (semiconductor relay) is built in the master cylinder solenoid and drives the pump motor
based on a signal from the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
C1253/53
Trouble Area
•
•
Motor system circuit (motor input circuit)
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hydraulic Brake Booster Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
2
BC
S28
ABS MTR
1
2
+BM1
Motor Relay
2
+BM2
S29
1
S28
32
S28
4
S29
GND1
GND2
GND3
M+1
M+2
Battery
MT-
MT+
Pump Motor
C132922E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the hydraulic brake booster (master cylinder solenoid), perform zero point
calibration (See page BC-20).
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (H/B MOTOR RELAY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
BC–119
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) Select "ACTIVE TEST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
H/B MOT RELAY
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Operation sound of motor can be
heard
Turns H/B motor relay ON / OFF
(e) Check operation sound of the H/B motor individually
when operating it with the intelligent tester.
OK:
The operation sound of the H/B motor can be
heard.
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (+BM TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connectors.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-2 (+BM1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S29-2 (+BM2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
+BM1
+BM2
S29
C124799E15
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (+BM CIRCUIT)
BC
BC–120
3
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S28
S28-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND1
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
GND2
GND3
S29
BC
C124799E16
OK
4
RECONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
Turn the ignition switch off.
Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Wait until the pump motor stops.
Depress the brake pedal several times until the pump
motor turns on.
(g) Wait until the pump stops.
(h) Repeat (f) and (g) 3 more times.
(i) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–121
A
REPLACE HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BC
BC–122
DTC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
C1254/54 Pressure Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The accumulator pressure sensor is connected to the skid control ECU in the master cylinder solenoid.
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
IG1
BC
GND
Accumulator
Pressure Sensor
VACC
VACC
PACC
PACC
ACCGND
ACCGND
VACC: Accumulator Pressure Sensor Power Supply Output
PACC: Accumulator Pressure Sensor Signal Input
ACCGND: Accumulator Pressure Sensor Ground
C124776E02
HINT:
If the code (C1254/54) is output, the following conditions will occur:
• The ABS, VSC TRAC, and BRAKE warning lights and SLIP and VSC OFF indicator lights will come on.
• The skid control buzzer sounds.
• Control of all systems other than EBD is canceled.
DTC No.
C1254/54
DTC Detection Condition
Accumulator pressure sensor malfunction
(Fluid pressure does not change when the pump
operates or when the brake is applied.)
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Hydraulic brake booster
Accumulator pressure sensor
Master cylinder pressure sensor
BC–123
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch off.
Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(e) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
ACC PRESS
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Accumulator pressure sensor
reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
(f)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
If the value is constant regardless
of pump operation, accumulator
pressure sensor malfunction is
suspected.
3.58 to 5 V
Check the accumulator output value.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Output value is within the "Normal Condition" range
A
Output value is out of the "Normal Condition" range
B
Output value is constant regardless of pump operation
B
B
BC
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
(c) Install the brake pedal effort gauge (SST), and bleed air.
SST 09709-29018
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(e) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
MAS CYL PRESS 1
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
(f)
0.3 to 1.95 V
With pedal effort of 49 N (5 kgf, 11
in.*Ibf)
Diagnostic Note
Front brake pressure: 1220 to
2320 kPa (11.4 to 23.7 kgf/cm2,
162 to 337 psi)
Check that the master cylinder pressure sensor's output
value is normal.
OK:
Master cylinder pressure sensor value is normal.
NG
OK
Normal Condition
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC–124
3
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
RECONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
Turn the ignition switch off.
Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Wait until the pump motor stops.
Depress the brake pedal and release it.
Wait for 25 minutes.
Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
END
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
BC–125
C1256/56 Accumulator Low Pressure
DESCRIPTION
The accumulator pressure sensor is connected to the skid control ECU in the master cylinder solenoid.
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control ECU
IG1
VACC
VACC
PACC
PACC
ACCGND
GND
Accumulator
Pressure Sensor
BC
ACCGND
VACC: Accumulator Pressure Sensor Power Supply Output
PACC: Accumulator Pressure Sensor Signal Input
ACCGND: Accumulator Pressure Sensor Ground
C124776E03
DTC No.
C1256/56
DTC Detecting Condition
Fluid pressure inside the accumulator is below the
standard value.
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Hydraulic brake booster
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor circuit
Accumulator pressure sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–126
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
When C1251/51, C1253/53, or C1254/54 is output together with C1256/56, inspect and repair the trouble
area indicated by C1251/51, C1253/53, or C1254/54 first.
1
RECONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
Turn the ignition switch off.
Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Wait for 99 seconds.
Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
HINT:
Excessive brake pedal operation results in abnormal
accumulator pressure consumption. This is normal.
B
BC
END
A
2
CHECK HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
(a) Check the hydraulic circuit (See page BR-17).
OK:
Hydraulic circuit is normal (No leakage).
NG
REPAIR HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
OK
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "DATA LIST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
ACC PRESS
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Accumulator pressure sensor
reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Normal Condition
3.58 to 5 V
Diagnostic Note
If the value is constant regardless
of pump operation, accumulator
pressure sensor malfunction is
suspected.
(d) Check that the accumulator's output value is normal.
OK:
Accumulator pressure sensor value is normal.
NG
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–127
OK
4
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–128
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1257/57 IG Power Source
DESCRIPTION
The motor relay (semiconductor relay) is built in the master cylinder solenoid and drives the pump motor
based on a signal from the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
C1257/57
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Open in motor system circuit (motor input circuit).
Hydraulic brake booster pump motor circuit
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
CHECK PUMP MOTOR OPERATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
BC
Turn the ignition switch off.
Disconnect the skid control ECU (S28) connector.
Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times.
Check pump motor operation.
OK:
Pump motor normally operates.
NG
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
OK
2
RECONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Turn the ignition switch off.
Reconnect the skid control ECU (S28) connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC–129
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1258/58 Transfer 4WD Position Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Transfer condition (2WD or 4WD) is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1258/58
The difference in 2WD/4WD information sent from the
ECM via CAN and the 4WD control switch (EXI3 signal)
continues for 5 seconds.
•
•
•
4WD control (4WD) switch
4WD control (4WD) switch circuit
4WD control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
4WD
Master Cylinder Solenoid
26
S28
8
EXI3
BC
4WD Control ECU
ADD
4WD Control (4WD) Switch
H4
18
GND
4
H2
2-4
8
5 2-4
C132923E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–130
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (EXI3 TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-26 (EXI3) - Body
ground
4WD control (4WD)
switch ON (Transfer
4WD position)
Below 1.5 V
S28-26 (EXI3) - Body
ground
4WD control (4WD)
switch ON (Transfer
2WD position)
8 to 14 V
EXI3
C121700E82
Result
BC
Condition
Proceed to
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC CHART.)
A
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE.)
B
NG
C
B
C
A
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Go to step 4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
2
BC–131
INSPECT ECM (4WD TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ECM Harness Side View:
Turn the ignition switch off.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E6-8 (4WD) - Body
ground
4WD control (4WD)
switch ON (Transfer
4WD position)
Below 1.5 V
E6-8 (4WD) - Body
ground
4WD control (4WD)
switch ON (Transfer
2WD position)
8 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 4
E6-8 (4WD)
BC
I044051E04
OK
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(c) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
NG
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC–132
4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL SWITCH (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control (4WD) switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
4WD Control (4WD) Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
F11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F11-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND
B059092E11
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
OK
5
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Check the select 2-4 and high-low system (See page TF46).
NG
BC
REPLACE 4WD CONTROL SWITCH
OK
6
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL ECU
(a) Check the select 2-4 and high-low system (See page TF46).
NG
OK
REPLACE 4WD CONTROL ECU
BC–133
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (4WD CONTROL ECU - 4WD CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control ECU (F9) connector and
4WD control (4WD) switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
Tester Connection
F9-8 (2-4)
NG
4WD Control (4WD) Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Specified Condition
F9-8 (2-4) - F11-5 (2-4)
Below 1 Ω
F9-8 (2-4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
F11
2-4
BC
I045763E05
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - 4WD CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control ECU (F10) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
EXI3
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
S28
F10-18
(ADD)
I045764E03
OK
Specified Condition
S28-26 (EXI3) - F10-18 (ADD)
Below 1 Ω
S28-26 (EXI3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–134
9
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-26 (EXI3) - B6-8 (4WD)
Below 1 Ω
S28-26 (EXI3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
EXI3
ECM Harness View:
BC
E6-8 (4WD)
I045573E03
Result
Condition
Proceed to
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC CHART.)
A
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE.)
B
NG
C
A
END
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–135
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1268/68 Transfer "L4" Position Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
After confirming that the transfer is in the L4 position, A-TRAC and downhill assist control will be activated
according to the vehicle conditions (See page BC-6).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
The L4 signal input to the ECU does not match the L4
signal output from the ECM.
C1268/68
4WD control (L4) switch
4WD control (L4) switch circuit
4WD control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
ECM
L4
21
S28
13
EXI4
BC
4WD Control ECU
L4
4WD Control (4WD) Switch
H4
24
GND 4
L4
LO
15
2 LO
C132923E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–136
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (EXI4 TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
EXI4
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-21 (EXI4) - Body
ground
4WD control (L4) switch
ON (Transfer L4
position)
Below 1.5 V
S28-21 (EXI4) - Body
ground
4WD control (L4) switch
OFF (Any transfer
position except L4)
8 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 4
C121700E97
OK
BC
2
PERFORM TEST MODE (SIGNAL CHECK)
(a) Check if the test mode (signal check) DTC is detected.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Test mode (signal check) DTC is output
A
Test mode (signal check) DTC is not output (When
troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC CHART.)
B
Test mode (signal check) DTC is not output (When
troubleshooting in accordance with the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE.)
C
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (L4 CIRCUIT)
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
BC–137
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
B
END
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
4
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL SWITCH (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control (4WD) switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
4WD Control (4WD) Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
F11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F11-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND
B059092E12
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
OK
5
BC
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Check the select high-low system (See page TF-43) or
the select 2-4 and high-low system (See page TF-46).
NG
REPLACE 4WD CONTROL SWITCH
OK
6
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL ECU
(a) Check the select high-low system (See page TF-43) or
the select 2-4 and high-low system (See page TF-46).
NG
OK
REPLACE 4WD CONTROL ECU
BC–138
7
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (4WD CONTROL ECU - 4WD CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control ECU connector and 4WD
control (L4) switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
Tester Connection
F9-15 (LO)
NG
4WD Control (L4) Switch Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Specified Condition
F9-15 (LO) - F11-2 (LO)
Below 1 Ω
F9-15 (LO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
F11
BC
LO
I045763E06
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - 4WD CONTROL ECU)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-21 (EXI4) - F9-24 (L4)
Below 1 Ω
S28-21 (EXI4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
EXI4
S28
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
F9-24
(L4)
I045765E03
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–139
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
9
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-21 (EXI4) - E6-13 (L4)
Below 1 Ω
S28-21 (EXI4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
EXI4
ECM Harness View:
BC
E6-13 (L4)
I045573E04
Result
Condition
Proceed to
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the DTC CHART.)
A
OK (When troubleshooting in accordance with the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE.)
B
NG
C
A
END
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–21
CALIBRATION
1.
Replacement / Adjustment Parts
DESCRIPTION
• After replacing the VSC relevant components or
performing "Front wheel alignment adjustment",
clearing and reading the sensor calibration data are
necessary.
• Follow the chart to perform calibration.
HINT:
For a rear air suspension vehicle, it is necessary to
obtain zero point calibration data (again) after
adjusting vehicle height.
Necessary Operations
Master cylinder solenoid (Skid control ECU)
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration.
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
1. Clearing zero point calibration data.
2. Yaw rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration.
Front wheel alignment
1. Clearing zero point calibration data.
2. Yaw rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration.
Rear air suspension
1. Clearing zero point calibration data
2. Yaw rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration
2.
DLC3:
CLEAR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION (SST CHECK
WIRE)
HINT:
After replacing the yaw rate and acceleration sensor,
make sure to clear zero point calibration data in the skid
control ECU and perform zero point calibration.
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Using SST, connect and disconnect terminals TS
and CG of the DLC3 4 times or more within 8
seconds.
SST 09843-18040
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
F100115E01
Normal System Code:
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
3.
OFF
BR03904E50
(c) Check that the warning light indicates the normal
system code.
(d) Remove the SST from the terminals of the DLC3.
(e) Using a check wire, perform zero point calibration of
the yaw rate and acceleration sensor.
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW
RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR (SST CHECK
WIRE)
After replacing the master cylinder solenoid and/or yaw
rate and acceleration sensor, make sure to perform yaw
rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration.
NOTICE:
• While obtaining the zero point, do not vibrate the
vehicle by tilting, moving or shaking it and keep it
in a stationary condition. (Do not start the engine.)
BC
BC–22
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
• Be sure to do this on a level surface (with an
inclination of less than 1 degree).
(a) Procedures for test mode:
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
DLC3:
(2) Using SST, connect terminals TS and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(3) Check that the steering wheel is in the straightahead position and more the shift lever to the P
position.
NOTICE:
DTC C1210/36 and C1336/39 will be recorded
if the shift lever is not in the P position (See
page BC-83).
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(5) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a
level surface for 2 seconds or more.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
F100115E01
(6) Check that the VSC TRAC warning light is
blinking in test mode.
NOTICE:
The VSC TRAC warning light stays on when
obtaining the zero point.
HINT:
• If the VSC TRAC warning light does not blink,
perform the zero point calibration again.
• The zero point calibration is performed only
once after the system enters test mode.
• Calibration cannot be performed again until
the stored data is cleared once.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
BC
OFF
BR03904E54
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
4.
CLEAR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION (INTELLIGENT
TESTER)
After replacing the yaw rate and acceleration sensor,
make sure to clear zero point calibration data in the skid
control ECU and perform zero point calibration.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Operate the intelligent tester to erase the codes.
I042828E01
F052309
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform zero point
calibration of the yaw rate and acceleration sensor.
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
5.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
BC–23
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW
RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR (INTELLIGENT
TESTER)
After replacing the master cylinder solenoid and/or yaw
rate and acceleration sensor, make sure to perform yaw
rate and acceleration sensor zero point calibration.
NOTICE:
• While obtaining the zero point, do not vibrate the
vehicle by tilting, moving or shaking it and keep it
in a stationary condition. (Do not start the engine.)
• Be sure to do this on a level surface (with an
inclination of less than 1 degree).
(a) Procedures for test mode.
(1) Check that the steering wheel is in the straightahead position and move the shift lever to the P
position.
NOTICE:
DTC C1210/36 and C1336/39 will be recorded
if the shift lever is not in the P position (See
page BC-83).
(2) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(4) Set the intelligent tester in test mode ("TEST
MODE").
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
(5) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a
level surface for 2 seconds or more.
I042828E01
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E55
(6) Check that the VSC TRAC warning light is
blinking in test mode.
NOTICE:
The VSC TRAC warning light stays on when
obtaining the zero point.
HINT:
• If the VSC TRAC warning light does not blink,
perform the zero point calibration again.
• The zero point calibration is performed only
once after the system enters test mode.
• Calibration cannot be performed again until
the stored data is cleared once.
BC
BC–140
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
C1337/37 Different Diameter Tire Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU measures the speed of each wheel by receiving signals from the speed sensor.
These signals are used for recognizing that all 4 wheels are operating properly. Therefore, all wheel
signals must be equal.
DTC No.
C1337/37
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
When either of the following condition is detected:
• Diameter is different between the 2 front wheels
and the 2 rear wheels.
• Wheel speed sensor fault
•
•
•
•
Speed sensor
Speed sensor rotor
Speed sensor circuit
Tire size
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
CHECK TIRE SIZE
(a) Check tire size and condition of all 4 wheels.
NG
BC
REPLACE TIRES SO THAT ALL 4 TIRES ARE
SAME IN SIZE
OK
2
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
(a) Check the front speed sensor circuit (See page BC-53)
and rear speed sensor circuit (See page BC-62).
NG
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
OK
3
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Check the front speed sensor circuit (See page BC-53)
and rear speed sensor circuit (See page BC-62).
NG
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Check the front speed sensor circuit (See page BC-53)
and rear speed sensor circuit (See page BC-62).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–141
OK
5
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page BC-39).
(b) Drive the vehicle at a speed of approximately 13 mph (20
km/h) or more for 60 seconds or more.
(c) Check if the same pending DTC is detected (See page
BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–142
DTC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
C1340/47 Center Differential Lock Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the center differential is locked, VSC control turns off and the VSC OFF indicator illuminates.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
C1340/47
BC
•
When the terminal IG1 voltage is between 10 and
14 V, there is an open in the center differential lock
circuit for 2 seconds or more.
A center diff. lock indicator OFF signal is
continuously output for 5 seconds or more with the
center differential locked (Multi Mode 4WD).
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Center diff. lock switch
Center diff. lock switch circuit
Center diff. lock indicator light circuit
4WD control ECU
BC–143
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
10
S28
6
Center
Diff. Lock
NEO
4WD Control ECU
IND2
P1
BC
20
27
S28
22
EXI
Center Diff. Lock Switch
DL
16
3
4
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
C132924E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–144
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (EXI TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
EXI
Transfer is in 4WD mode (Multi Mode 4WD only).
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-27 (EXI) - Body
ground
Center diff. locked
Below 1.5 V
S28-27 (EXI) - Body
ground
Center diff. free
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 4
C121700E84
OK
BC
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (NEO TERMINAL)
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-10 (NEO) - Body
ground
Center diff. locked
Below 2 V
S28-10 (NEO) - Body
ground
Center diff. free
10 to 14 V
HINT:
The center diff. lock indicator light comes on while the
center differential is being switched to lock. Therefore,
perform the measurement after confirming that the
indicator light comes on and the center differential is
actually locked by driving the vehicle.
NEO
C139796E03
NG
Go to step 9
OK
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
BC–145
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
4
INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SWITCH (GROUND TERMINAL)
Center Diff. Lock Switch Harness Side Connector
Front View:
(a) Disconnect the center diff. lock switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
D4
NG
I044042E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D4-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GROUND CIRCUIT)
OK
5
INSPECT CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Push-lock Type:
Not
Pushed in
Pushed in
D4
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D4-3 - D4-4
Switch is pushed in
Below 1 Ω
D4-3 - D4-4
Switch is not pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
NG
I044044E03
REPLACE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL LOCK
SWITCH
OK
6
INSPECT 4WD CONTROL ECU
(a) Check the select high-low system (See page TF-43) or
the select 2-4 and high-low system (See page TF-46).
NG
OK
REPLACE 4WD CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–146
7
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (4WD CONTROL ECU - CENTER DIFFERENTIAL
LOCK SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control ECU (F9) connector and
center diff. lock switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
F9-16 (DL)
NG
Center Diff. Lock Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F9-16 (DL) - D4-3
Below 1 Ω
F9-16 (DL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
D4
BC
I045789E02
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - 4WD CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control ECU (F10) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-27 (EXI) - F10-22 (P1)
Below 1 Ω
S28-27 (EXI) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
OK
EXI
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
F10-22 (P1)
I045768E02
Go to step 12
BC–147
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
9
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - 4WD CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the 4WD control ECU (F9) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-10 (NEO) - F9-20 (IND2)
Below 1 Ω
S28-10 (NEO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
NEO
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
4WD Control ECU Harness View:
BC
F9-20 (IND2)
I046170E02
OK
BC–148
10
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-10 (NEO) - C11-6
Below 1 Ω
S28-10 (NEO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
NEO
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C11-6
BC
I045338E14
OK
11
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
12
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–149
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–212
BRAKE CONTROL – REAR SPEED SENSOR
REAR SPEED SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
BC
SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
C119747E02
BRAKE CONTROL – REAR SPEED SENSOR
BC–213
REMOVAL
HINT:
Replacement of RH side is same as that of LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
F043111
(b) Remove the nut and speed sensor rear from the
axle hub.
NOTICE:
• Do not stick and foreign matter on the sensor
tip.
• Do not let the foreign matter into the sensor
installation hole.
F043113
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
(a) Install the rear speed sensor with the nut to the
steering knuckle.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure the sensor tip is clean.
F043113
(b) Connect the speed sensor connector.
F043111
2.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 110 N*m (1.122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
3.
CHECK VSC SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
BC
BC–150
DTC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
C1380/64 Stop Light Control Relay Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Upon receiving the downhill assist control or hill-start assist control operating signal from the skid control
ECU, the relay contact turns on and the stop light comes on.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
C1380/64
BC
•
When the voltage at the IG1 terminal is between 10
V and 14 V and the stop light driving output (STPO)
is on, a signal has not been input to the STP
terminal for 5 seconds or more.
When the voltage at the IG1 terminal is between 10
V and 14 V and the stop light driving output (STPO)
is off, the input signal at the STP is different from
the input signal at the STP2 for 5 seconds or more.
Trouble Area
•
•
Stop light operation relay
Stop light operation relay circuit
BC–151
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Stop Light Switch
45
S28
1
2
STP2
4
7
5
3
1
2
S28
STP
16
S28
STPO
BC
Stop Light Operation
(STOP LP CTRL)
2
STOP
IG1
1
Rear Combination Light LH
6
STOP
1
from Ignition Switch
Rear Combination Light RH
from Battery
6
STOP
1
to High Mounted
Stop Light
C132920E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–152
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK STOP LIGHT SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Check that the stop light comes on when the brake pedal
is depressed, and goes off when the brake pedal is
released.
OK:
Stop light switch function is normal.
HINT:
Check the stop light bulb as it may have burnt out.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (STP TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
BC
S28
STP
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-7 (STP) - Body
ground
Stop light switch ON
(Brake pedal
depressed)
8 to 14 V
S28-7 (STP) - Body
ground
Stop light switch OFF
(Brake pedal released)
Below 1.5 V
NG
C121700E86
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STP CIRCUIT)
BC–153
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
3
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (STP2 TERMINAL)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
STP
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-7 (STP) - S28-45 (STP2)
Below 1 Ω
S28
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STP2 CIRCUIT)
STP2
C121700E87
OK
4
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY)
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(d) Select "ACTIVE TEST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
STOP LIGHT RELAY
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Turns stop light operation relay ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Observe rear combination light
(Does not come on for 5 sec. or more)
(e) Check that "ON" and "OFF" of the stop light can be
shown on the rear combination light by the intelligent
tester.
OK:
The stop light turns on or off in accordance with the
intelligent tester.
OK
NG
Go to step 8
BC
BC–154
5
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY (POWER SOURCE TERMINAL)
(a) Remove the stop light operation relay.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Engine Room R/B:
Stop Light
Operation Relay
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
8 to 14 V
5 - Body ground
8 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
I045958E01
OK
BC
6
INSPECT STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(When battery positive voltage is applied to terminal
1 and battery negative voltage to terminal 2.)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery positive voltage is applied to terminal
1 and battery negative voltage to terminal 2.)
F052359E01
NG
OK
REPLACE STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
BC–155
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
7
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (STPO TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
STPO
S28
Instal the stop light operation relay.
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-16 (STPO) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STPO CIRCUIT)
C121700E88
OK
8
RECONFIRM DTC
BC
(a) Clear the DTC (See page BC-39).
(b) Check if the same DTC is detected (See page BC-39).
HINT:
Reinstall the sensors, connectors, etc. and restore the
previous vehicle conditions before rechecking for DTCs.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
END
BC–156
9
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY (POWER SOURCE TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the stop light switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Stop Light Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S12
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S12-2 Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
C124801E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
OK
10
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
BC
2
1
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S12-1 - S12-2
Switch pin free
Below 1 Ω
S12-1 - S12-2
Switch pin pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Pushed in
3
4
Free
S12
C124796E07
OK
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
BC–157
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
11
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (STOP LIGHT SWITCH - STOP LIGHT OPERATION
RELAY)
(a) Remove the stop light operation relay.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Stop Light Switch Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
S12
Specified Condition
S12-1 - 4
Below 1 Ω
S12-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Engine Room R/B:
Stop Light
Operation Relay
BC
I046068E02
OK
12
INSPECT STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
NG
F052359E01
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE STOP LIGHT OPERATION RELAY
BC–158
13
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (REAR COMBINATION LIGHT - STOP LIGHT
OPERATION RELAY)
Rear Combination Light Harness Side Connector
Front View:
(a) Disconnect the rear combination light connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
LH
R14 :LH
R15 :RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R14-1 - 3
Below 1 Ω
R14-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R14-6 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
RH
Engine Room R/B:
Stop Light
Operation Relay
BC
I046069E04
OK
END
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R15-1 - 3
Below 1 Ω
R15-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R15-6 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–159
DTC
U0073/94 Control Module Communication Bus OFF
DTC
U0100/65 Lost Communication with ECM / PCM
DTC
U0123/62
Lost Communication with Yaw Rate Sensor
Module
DTC
U0124/95
Lost Communication with Lateral Acceleration
Sensor Module
DTC
U0126/63
Lost Communication with Steering Angle Sensor Module
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to CAN communication system (See page CA-6).
BC
BC–160
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
ABS Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
If any of the following is detected, the ABS warning light remains on.
• The skid control ECU connectors are disconnected from the skid control ECU.
• There is a malfunction in the skid control ECU internal circuit.
• There is an open in the harness between the combination meter and skid control ECU.
HINT:
There is a case that the intelligent tester cannot be used when the skid control ECU is abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
4
ECU-IG
BC
ABS
GAUGE
29
S28
WA
46
S28
IG1
from Ignition Switch
15
1
S28
GND1
32
S28
GND2
4
S29
GND3
C132925E04
BC–161
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
2
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
BC
OK
3
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (IG1 TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-46 (IG1) -Body ground
10 to 14 V
S28
NG
IG1
C121700E89
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IG1 CIRCUIT)
BC–162
4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
GND1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S28-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND2
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
S29
GND3
BC
C124799E17
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-29 (WA) - C11-4
Below 1 Ω
S28-29 (WA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
WA
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C11-4
I045766E03
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
6
BC–163
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–164
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
ABS Warning Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
If any of the following is detected, the ABS warning light remains on.
• The skid control ECU connectors are disconnected from the skid control ECU.
• There is a malfunction in the skid control ECU internal circuit.
• There is an open in the harness between the combination meter and skid control ECU.
HINT:
There is a case that the intelligent tester cannot be used when the skid control ECU is abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
4
ECU-IG
BC
ABS
GAUGE
29
S28
WA
46
S28
IG1
from Ignition Switch
15
1
S28
GND1
32
S28
GND2
4
S29
GND3
C132925E05
BC–165
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT ABS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Check that the ABS warning light comes on.
OK:
ABS warning light comes on.
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-29 (WA) - C11-4
Below 1 Ω
S28-29 (WA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
WA
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C11-4
I045766E04
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–166
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
VSC TRAC Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
If the skid control ECU stores DTCs to shut down VSC and TRAC operation, the VSC TRAC warning light
comes on in the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Combination Meter Assembly
36
S28
18
VSCW
VSC TRAC
BC
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
C132926E08
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
BC–167
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
2
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and
combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
VSCW
S28
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
Specified Condition
S28-36 (VSCW) - C10-18
Below 1 Ω
S28-36 (VSCW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10-18
I045338E15
OK
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–168
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
VSC TRAC Warning Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
If the skid control ECU stores DTCs to shut down VSC and TRAC operation, the VSC TRAC warning light
comes on in the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Combination Meter Assembly
36
S28
18
VSCW
VSC TRAC
BC
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
C132926E09
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT VSC TRAC WARNING LIGHT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Ground terminal VSCW of the skid control ECU.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the VSC TRAC warning light comes on.
BC–169
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK:
VSC TRAC warning light comes on.
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
VSCW
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-36 (VSCW) - C10-18
Below 1 Ω
S28-36 (VSCW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC
C10-18
I045338E16
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–170
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Brake Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The BRAKE warning light comes on when brake fluid is insufficient, the parking brake is applied or the
EBD is defective.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
19
C8
ECU-IG
BRAKE
3
S29
BRL
46
S28
IG1
28
S28
PKB
41
S28
LBL
1
S28
GND1
32
S28
GND2
4
S29
GND3
Parking Brake Switch
1
BC
15
GAUGE
from Ignition Switch
C10
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
1
2
C149936E01
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–171
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
A
2
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
3
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
OK
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
BC
BC–172
4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (IG1 TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-46 (IG1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IG1 CIRCUIT)
IG1
C121700E90
OK
BC
5
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (GND TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
GND1
GND2
S28
S29
GND3
C124799E20
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S28-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND CIRCUIT)
BC–173
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
6
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the parking brake switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
P4
Free
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P4-1 - Body ground
Parking brake switch
ON
(Switch pin free)
Below 1 Ω
P4-1 - Body ground
Parking brake switch
OFF
(Switch pin pushed in)
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed in
I044058E01
NG
REPLACE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - PARKING BRAKE SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
S28-28 (PKB) - P4-1
Below 1 Ω
S28-28 (PKB) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
PKB
Parking Brake Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
P4
1
C124797E05
OK
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC
BC–174
8
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S29
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S29-3 (BRL) - C8-19
Below 1 Ω
S29-3 (BRL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
BRL
Combination Meter (Left Side of the
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
BC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C8-19
I045767E04
OK
9
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–175
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Brake Warning Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
The BRAKE warning light comes on when brake fluid is insufficient, the parking brake is applied or the
EBD is defective.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
19
C8
ECU-IG
BRAKE
3
S29
BRL
46
S28
IG1
28
S28
PKB
41
S28
LBL
1
S28
GND1
32
S28
GND2
4
S29
GND3
Parking Brake Switch
1
15
GAUGE
BC
from Ignition Switch
C10
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
1
2
C149936E02
BC–176
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Check that the BRAKE warning light comes on.
OK:
BRAKE warning light comes on.
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
BC
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT GAUGE FUSE
(a) Remove the GAUGE fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Check the GAUGE fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE GAUGE FUSE
BC–177
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Install the GAUGE fuse.
(b) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
S29
BRL
Combination Meter (Right Side of the
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
C8-19
Specified Condition
S29-3 (BRL) - C8-19
Below 1 Ω
S29-3 (BRL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC
I045767E05
OK
5
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU (S29) connector and
combination meter connector.
(b) Check if the indicators (shift position, airbag etc.) other
than BRAKE warning light operate normally.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Indicators OK
A
Indicators NG
B
B
A
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
BC–178
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
VSC OFF Indicator Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
When the center differential is locked, VSC control turns off and the VSC OFF indicator illuminates.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
17
35
S28
WT
27
S28
EXI
VSC OFF
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
BC
4WD Control ECU
P1
22
Center Diff. Lock Switch
DL
16
3
4
C132928E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs (See page BC-39).
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
BC–179
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTC
A
2
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
3
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
BC
OK
4
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (EXI TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Transfer is in 4WD mode (Multi Mode 4WD only).
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-27 (EXI) - Body
ground
Center diff. free
10 to 14 V
NG
EXI
C121700E91
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (EXI CIRCUIT)
BC–180
5
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-35 (WT) - C10-17
Below 1 Ω
S28-35 (WT) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
WT
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10-17
BC
I045338E17
OK
6
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–24
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
TEST MODE PROCEDURE
1.
DLC3:
BC
TEST MODE (SIGNAL CHECK) PROCEDURE (SST
CHECK WIRE)
When having replaced the master cylinder solenoid and/
or yaw rate and acceleration sensor, perform zero point
calibration of the yaw rate and acceleration sensor.
HINT:
• If the ignition switch is turned from the ON to the ACC
or LOCK position during test mode, DTCs of the
signal check function will be erased.
• During test mode, the ECU records all DTCs of the
signal check function. By performing the signal check,
the codes are erased if normality is confirmed. The
codes left over are the codes where an abnormality
was found.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Check that the steering wheel is in the straightahead position and move the shift lever to the P
position.
(c) Using SST, connect terminals TS and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
F100115E01
(e) Check that the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights
blink in test mode.
HINT:
If the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights do not
blink, inspect the TS and CG terminal circuit and the
ABS and VSC TRAC warning light circuits.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
Trouble Area
TS and CG terminal circuit
OFF
See procedure
BC-207
ABS warning light circuit
BC-157 or BC-161
VSC TRAC warning light circuit
BC-163 or BC-165
BR03904E52
(f) Start the engine.
(g) Using a check wire, perform the ABS sensor
(acceleration sensor, master cylinder pressure
sensor, center diff. lock detection switch, L4
detection switch and speed sensor) and VSC
sensor (yaw rate sensor and downhill assist control
operation switch) signal checks in test mode (ABS
sensor: See procedure "A" to "F", VSC sensor: See
procedure "G" to "I").
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
ACCELERATION SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (SST
CHECK WIRE) (Procedure "A")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a level
surface for 1 second or more.
3.
MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL
CHECK (SST CHECK WIRE) (Procedure "B")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Leave the vehicle in a stationary condition and
release the brake pedal for 1 second or more, and
quickly depress the brake pedal with a force of 98 N
(10 kgf, 22 lbf) or more for 1 second or more.
HINT:
• At this time, the ABS warning light stays on for 3
seconds.
• While the ABS warning light stays on, continue to
depress the brake pedal with a force of 98 N (10
kgf, 22 lbf) or more.
• The ABS warning light comes on for 3 seconds
every time the brake pedal operation above is
performed.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
BC–25
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
4.
CENTER DIFF. LOCK DETECTION SWITCH SIGNAL
CHECK (4WD) (SST CHECK WIRE) (Procedure "C")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Check the center diff. lock switch.
(1) Push the center diff. lock switch on to lock the
center differential.
(2) Push the center diff. lock switch off to unlock the
center differential.
5.
L4 DETECTION SWITCH SIGNAL CHECK (4WD) (SST
CHECK WIRE) (Procedure "D")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Check the 4WD control (L4) switch.
(1) Turn the H-L switch to the L position to put the
vehicle in L4 mode.
(2) Turn the H-L switch to the H position to put the
vehicle in H4 mode.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
BC
BC–26
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
6.
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (SST CHECK
WIRE) (Procedure "E")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Check the backward signal.
(1) Drive the vehicle in reverse for more than 1
second at 2 mph (3 km/h) or higher.
HINT:
Drive the vehicle in reverse and check the speed
sensor signal. Note that the signal check cannot
be completed if the vehicle speed is 28 mph (45
km/h) or more.
(c) Check the forward signal.
(1) Drive the vehicle straight forward.
Drive the vehicle at a speed of 28 mph (45 km/h)
or higher for several seconds and check that the
ABS warning light goes off.
HINT:
The signal check may not be completed if the
vehicle has its wheels spun or the steering
wheel turned during this check.
(d) Stop the vehicle.
NOTICE:
• Before performing the speed sensor signal
check, complete the acceleration sensor,
master cylinder pressure sensor, center diff.
lock detection switch and L4 detection switch
signal checks.
• The speed sensor signal check may not be
completed if the speed sensor signal check is
started while turning the steering wheel or
spinning the wheels.
• After the ABS warning light goes off, if the
vehicle speed exceeds 50 mph (80 km/h),
signal check code will be stored again.
Decelerate or stop before the speed reaches
50 mph (80 km/h).
• If the signal check has not been completed,
the ABS warning light blinks while driving
and the ABS system does not operate.
HINT:
When the signal check has been completed, the
ABS warning light goes off while driving and blinks
in the test mode pattern while stationary.
7.
READ DTC OF ABS SENSOR (SST CHECK WIRE)
(Procedure "F")
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(b) Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT:
• See the list of DTC (See procedure "J").
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
BC
DLC3:
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
F100115E02
BC–27
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
• If every sensor is normal, the normal system
code is output. (A cycle of 0.25 second ON and
0.25 second OFF is repeated.)
• If more than 1 malfunction is detected at the
same time, the lowest numbered code will be
displayed first.
Trouble Code (Example Codes 72 and 76):
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
Repeat
ON
OFF
Code 72
Code 76
I042842E04
(c) After the check, disconnect the SST from terminals
TC and CG of the DLC3.
8.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
YAW RATE SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (SST CHECK
WIRE) (Procedure "G")
(a) Check that the VSC TRAC warning light is blinking
in test mode.
(b) Check the zero point voltage of the yaw rate sensor.
(1) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a
level surface for 1 second or more.
OFF
BR03904E52
Start Position
Within +- 5ᶟ
End Position
F002135E16
(c) Check the output of the yaw rate sensor and the
direction of the steering angle sensor.
(1) Shift the shift lever to the D position and drive
the vehicle at a vehicle speed of approximately 3
mph (5 km/h), turn the steering wheel either to
the left or right 90° or more, and turn the vehicle
through 180 degrees.
(2) Stop the vehicle and shift the shift lever to the P
position. Check that the skid control buzzer
sounds for 3 seconds.
HINT:
• If the skid control buzzer sounds, the signal
check is completed normally.
• If the skid control buzzer does not sound,
check the skid control buzzer circuit (See
page BC-200), then perform the signal check
again.
• If the skid control buzzer still will not sound,
there is a malfunction in the yaw rate sensor,
so check the DTC.
• Drive the vehicle in a 180° circle. At the end
of the turn, the direction of the vehicle should
be within 180°+- 5° of its start position.
• Do not spin the wheels.
BC
BC–28
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
9.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL OPERATION SWITCH
SIGNAL CHECK (4WD) (SST CHECK WIRE)
(Procedure "H")
(a) Check that the VSC TRAC warning light is blinking
in test mode.
(b) Check the downhill assist control switch.
(1) Push the downhill assist control switch on.
(2) Push the downhill assist control switch off.
BR03904E52
DLC3:
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
F100115E02
BC
Trouble Code (Example Codes 71 and 72):
10. READ DTC OF VSC SENSOR (SST CHECK WIRE)
(Procedure "I")
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(b) Read the number of blinks of the VSC TRAC
warning light.
HINT:
• See the list of DTC (See procedure "J").
• If every sensor is normal, the normal system
code is output. (A cycle of 0.25 second ON and
0.25 second OFF is repeated.)
• If more than 1 malfunction is detected at the
same time, the lowest numbered code will be
displayed first.
1.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
Repeat
ON
OFF
Code 71
Code 72
I042841E01
(c) After performing the check, disconnect the SST
from terminals TS and CG, TC and CG of the DLC3
and turn the ignition switch off.
11. DTC OF SIGNAL CHECK FUNCTION (SST CHECK
WIRE) (Procedure "J")
ABS sensor:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C1271/71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
C1272/72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
C1273/73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
C1274/74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Code No.
Diagnosis
C1275/75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1276/76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1277/77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1278/78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1279/79
Acceleration sensor is faulty
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
C1281/81
Master cylinder pressure sensor output signal is faulty
Master cylinder pressure sensor
C1282/82 1)
Center differential lock position switch malfunction
Center diff. lock switch
C1283/83 (*1)
L4 position switch malfunction
4WD control (L4) switch
(*
BC–29
Trouble Area
(*1): 4WD
VSC sensor:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C0371/71
Yaw rate sensor output signal malfunction
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
C1379/74
Malfunction in downhill assist control operation switch
Downhill assist control switch
HINT:
The codes in this table are output only in test mode
(signal check).
12. TEST MODE (SIGNAL CHECK) PROCEDURE
(INTELLIGENT TESTER)
When having replaced the master cylinder solenoid and/
or yaw rate and acceleration sensor, perform zero point
calibration of the yaw rate and acceleration sensor.
HINT:
• If the ignition switch is turned from the ON to the ACC
or LOCK position during test mode, DTCs of the
signal check function will be erased.
• During test mode, the ECU records all DTCs of the
signal check function. By performing the signal check,
the codes are erased if normality is confirmed. The
codes left over are the codes where an abnormality
was found.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Check that the steering wheel is in the straightahead position and move the shift lever to the P
position.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
I042828E01
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
BC
BC–30
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Operate the intelligent tester in test mode ("SIGNAL
CHECK").
I044074
(f)
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
Check that the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights
blink in test mode.
HINT:
If the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights do not
blink, inspect the TS and CG terminal circuit and the
ABS and VSC TRAC warning light circuits.
Trouble Area
TS and CG terminal circuit
OFF
See procedure
BC-207
ABS warning light
BC-157 or BC-161
VSC TRAC warning light
BC-163 or BC-165
BR03904E52
BC
(g) Start the engine.
(h) Using the intelligent tester, perform the ABS sensor
(acceleration sensor, master cylinder pressure
sensor, center diff. lock detection switch, L4
detection switch and speed sensor) and VSC
sensor (yaw rate sensor and downhill assist control
operation switch) signal checks in test mode (ABS
sensor: See procedure "K" to "P", VSC sensor: See
procedure "Q" to "S").
13. ACCELERATION SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK
(INTELLIGENT TESTER) (Procedure "K")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Keep the vehicle in the stationary condition on a
level surface for 1 second or more.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
14. MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL
CHECK (INTELLIGENT TESTER) (Procedure "L")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–31
(b) Leave the vehicle in a stationary condition and
release the brake pedal for 1 second or more, and
quickly depress the brake pedal with a force of 98 N
(10 kgf, 22 lbf) or more for 1 second or more.
HINT:
• At this time, the ABS warning light stays on for 3
seconds.
• While the ABS warning light stays on, continue to
depress the brake pedal with a force of 98 N (10
kgf, 22 lbf) or more.
• The ABS warning light comes on for 3 seconds
every time the brake pedal operation above is
performed.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
16. L4 DETECTION SWITCH SIGNAL CHECK (4WD)
(INTELLIGENT TESTER) (Procedure "N")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Check the 4WD control (L4) switch.
(1) Turn the H-L switch to the L position to put the
vehicle in L4 mode.
(2) Turn the H-L switch to the H position to put the
vehicle in H4 mode.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
15. CENTER DIFF. LOCK DETECTION SWITCH SIGNAL
CHECK (4WD) (INTELLIGENT TESTER) (Procedure
"M")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Check the center diff. lock switch.
(1) Push the center diff. lock switch on to lock the
center differential.
(2) Push the center diff. lock switch off to unlock the
center differential.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E56
17. SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (INTELLIGENT
TESTER) (Procedure "O")
(a) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in test
mode.
(b) Check the backward signal.
(1) Drive the vehicle in reverse for more than 1
second at 2 mph (3 km/h) or higher.
HINT:
Drive the vehicle in reverse and check the speed
sensor signal. Note that the signal check cannot
be completed if the vehicle speed is 28 mph (45
km/h) or more.
BC
BC–32
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Check the forward signal.
(1) Drive the vehicle straight forward. Drive the
vehicle at a speed of 28 mph (45 km/h) or higher
for several seconds and check that the ABS
warning light goes off.
HINT:
The signal check may not be completed if the
vehicle has its wheels spun or the steering
wheel turned during this check.
(d) Stop the vehicle.
NOTICE:
• Before performing the speed sensor signal
check, complete the acceleration sensor,
master cylinder pressure sensor, center diff.
lock detection switch and L4 detection switch
signal checks.
• The speed sensor signal check may not be
completed if the speed sensor signal check is
started while turning the steering wheel or
spinning the wheels.
• After the ABS warning light goes off, if the
vehicle speed exceeds 50 mph (80 km/h), a
signal check code will be stored again.
Decelerate or stop before the speed reaches
50 mph (80 km/h).
• If the signal check has not been completed,
the ABS warning light blinks while driving
and the ABS system does not operate.
HINT:
When the signal check has been completed, the
ABS warning light goes off while driving and blinks
in the test mode pattern while stationary.
18. READ DTC OF ABS SENSOR (INTELLIGENT
TESTER) (Procedure "P")
(a) Read the DTC(s) by following the tester screen.
HINT:
• Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
• See the list of DTC (See procedure "T").
BC
19. YAW RATE SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (INTELLIGENT
TESTER) (Procedure "Q")
(a) Check that the VSC TRAC warning light is blinking
in test mode.
(b) Check the zero point voltage of the yaw rate sensor.
(1) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a
level surface for 1 second or more.
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Check the output of the yaw rate sensor and the
direction of the steering angle sensor.
(1) Shift the shift lever to the D position and drive
the vehicle at a vehicle speed of approximately 3
mph (5 km/h), turn the steering wheel either to
the left or right 90° or more, and turn the vehicle
through 180 degrees.
(2) Stop the vehicle and shift the shift lever to the P
position. Check that the skid control buzzer
sounds for 3 seconds.
HINT:
• If the skid control buzzer sounds, the signal
check is completed normally.
• If the skid control buzzer does not sound,
check the skid control buzzer circuit (See
page BC-200), then perform the signal check
again.
• If the skid control buzzer still will not sound,
there is a malfunction in the yaw rate sensor,
so check the DTC.
• Drive the vehicle in a 180° circle. At the end
of the turn, the direction of the vehicle should
be within 180°+- 5° of its start position.
• Do not spin the wheels.
Start Position
Within +- 5ᶟ
End Position
F002135E16
Test Mode:
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR03904E52
20. DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL OPERATION SWITCH
SIGNAL CHECK (4WD) (INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(Procedure "R")
(a) Check that the VSC TRAC warning light is blinking
in test mode.
(b) Check the downhill assist control switch.
(1) Push the downhill assist control switch on.
(2) Push the downhill assist control switch off.
21. READ DTC OF VSC SENSOR (INTELLIGENT
TESTER) (Procedure "S")
(a) Read the DTC(s) by following the tester screen.
HINT:
• Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
• See the list of DTC (See procedure "T").
22. DTC OF SIGNAL CHECK FUNCTION (INTELLIGENT
TESTER) (Procedure "T")
ABS sensor:
Code No.
BC–33
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C1271/71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
C1272/72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
C1273/73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
C1274/74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Speed sensor rotor
BC
BC–34
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Code No.
Diagnosis
C1275/75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1276/76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1277/77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1278/78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed
sensor
Speed sensor rotor
C1279/79
Acceleration sensor is faulty
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
C1281/81
Master cylinder pressure sensor output signal is faulty
Master cylinder pressure sensor
C1282/82 1)
Center differential lock position switch malfunction
Center diff. lock switch
C1283/83 (*1)
L4 position switch malfunction
4WD control (L4) switch
(*
Trouble Area
(*1): 4WD
VSC sensor:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C0371/71
Yaw rate sensor output signal malfunction
Yaw rate and acceleration sensor
C1379/74
Malfunction in downhill assist control operation switch
Downhill assist control switch
HINT:
The codes in this table are output only in test mode
(signal check).
BC
BC–181
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
VSC OFF Indicator Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
When the center differential is locked, VSC control turns off and the VSC OFF indicator illuminates.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
35
S28
17
WT
VSC OFF
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
BC
4WD Control ECU
P1
27
S28
22
EXI
Center Diff. Lock Switch
DL
16
4
3
C132928E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT VSC OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Ground terminal WT of the skid control ECU.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the VSC OFF indicator light comes on.
OK:
VSC OFF indicator light comes on.
BC–182
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-35 (WT) - C10-17
Below 1 Ω
S28-35 (WT) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
WT
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
BC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10-17
I045338E18
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–183
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Slip Indicator Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The SLIP indicator blinks during VSC, TRAC, A-TRAC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control or hill-start
assist control operation.
When the system fails, the SLIP indicator comes on to warn the driver (See page BC-38).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
34
S28
20
IND
BC
SLIP
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
C132926E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
BC–184
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
2
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and
combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
BC
IND
S28
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
Specified Condition
S28-34 (IND) - C10-20
Below 1 Ω
S28-34 (IND) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10-20
I045338E19
OK
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–214
BRAKE CONTROL – YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
BC
YAWRATE SENSOR
C131293E01
BRAKE CONTROL – YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
BC–215
CONSOLE UPPER PANEL
GARNISH NO. 1
CONSOLE UPPER PANEL
GARNISH NO. 2
CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
CONSOLE PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
BC
CONSOLE BOX
ASSEMBLY REAR
B120191E03
BC–185
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Slip Indicator Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
The SLIP indicator blinks during VSC, TRAC, A-TRAC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control or hill-start
assist control operation.
When the system fails, the SLIP indicator comes on to warn the driver (See page BC-38).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
34
S28
20
IND
BC
SLIP
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
C132926E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Ground terminal IND of the skid control ECU.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the SLIP indicator light comes on.
BC–186
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK:
SLIP indicator light comes on.
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
IND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-34 (IND) - C10-20
Below 1 Ω
S28-34 (IND) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC
C10-20
I045338E20
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–187
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Downhill Assist Control Indicator Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The downhill assist control indicator light comes on when the downhill assist control is ready (See page
BC-6).
HINT:
Even if the downhill assist control switch is pressed, the downhill assist control indicator light will blink and
downhill assist control will not be activated under the following conditions:
• Transfer is in 2WD or H4 mode.
• ABS system is malfunctioning.
• Temperature of the hydraulic brake booster increases and downhill assist control is temporarily
canceled.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
33
12
S28
HDCW
44
S28
HDCS
BC
Downhill
Assist Control
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
Downhill Assist Control Switch
4
3
C132929E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–188
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
2
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
BC
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and
combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-33 (HDCW) - C11-12
Below 1 Ω
S28-33 (HDCW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HDCW
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C11-12
I045338E30
OK
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
BC–189
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
5
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (HDCS TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-44 (HDCS) - Body
ground
Downhill assist
control switch is not
pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
HDCS
C121700E95
BC
NG
6
INSPECT DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the downhill assist control switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Push-lock Type:
Not
Pushed in
Pushed in
Condition
Specified Condition
D5-3 - D5-4
Switch is pushed in
Below 1 Ω
D5-3 - D5-4
Switch is not pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
D5
I044044E04
OK
Tester Connection
NG
REPLACE DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL
SWITCH
BC–190
7
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - DOWNHILL ASSIST
CONTROL SWITCH)
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Downhill Assist Control Switch
Harness Side Connector Front View:
END
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
D5-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
F052063E07
BC
S28-44 (HDCS) - D5-3
S28-44 (HDCS) - Body ground
HDCS
D5
OK
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–191
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Downhill Assist Control Indicator Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
The downhill assist control indicator light comes on when the downhill assist control is ready (See page
BC-6).
HINT:
Even if the downhill assist control switch is pressed, the downhill assist control indicator light will blink and
downhill assist control will not be activated under the following conditions:
• Transfer is in 2WD or H4 mode.
• ABS system is malfunctioning.
• Temperature of the hydraulic brake booster increases and downhill assist control is temporarily
canceled.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
33
12
S28
HDCW
44
S28
HDCS
BC
Downhill
Assist Control
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
Downhill Assist Control Switch
4
3
C132929E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–192
1
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL INDICATOR LIGHT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Ground terminal HDCW of the skid control ECU.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the downhill assist control indicator light
comes on.
OK:
downhill assist control indicator light comes on.
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
BC
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-33 (HDCW) - C11-12
Below 1 Ω
S28-33 (HDCW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
HDCW
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C11-12
I045338E31
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
BC–193
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (HDCS TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-44 (HDCS) - Body
ground
Downhill assist control
switch is pushed in
Below 1 Ω
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
HDCS
C121700E92
NG
5
INSPECT DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the downhill assist control switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Push-lock Type:
Not
Pushed in
Pushed in
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D5-3 - D5-4
Switch is pushed in
Below 1 Ω
D5-3 - D5-4
Switch is not pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
D5
I044044E04
OK
BC
NG
REPLACE DOWNHILL ASSIST CONTROL
SWITCH
BC–194
6
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - DOWNHILL ASSIST
CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Downhill Assist Control Switch
Harness Side Connector Front View:
HDCS
D5
F052063E08
OK
BC
END
Specified Condition
S28-44 (HDCS) - D5-3
Below 1 Ω
S28-44 (HDCS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
D5-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–195
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
AUTO LSD Indicator Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
Engaging the AUTO LSD switch causes the AUTO LSD indicator light to come on when the AUTO LSD is
ready (See page BC-6).
The AUTO LSD will not operate even if the AUTO LSD switch is pressed under the following conditions:
• TRAC and VSC system is faulty.
• Temperature inside the hydraulic brake booster increases and the AUTO LSD is halted.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
15
17
S28
INFR
AUTO LSD
BC
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
AUTO LSD Switch
4
3
43
S28
CSW
C132929E08
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
(a) Check the skid control ECU Connector's connecting
condition.
BC–196
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
2
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and
combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
BC
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-15 (INFR) - C10-17
Below 1 Ω
S28-15 (INFR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
INFR
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10-17
I045338E23
OK
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (See page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–197
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
5
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (CSW TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-43 (CSW) - Body
ground
AUTO LSD switch is
not pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
CSW
C121700E93
NG
6
INSPECT AUTO LSD SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the AUTO LSD switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Momentary Type:
Not
Pushed in
Pushed in
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A42-3 - A42-4
Switch is pushed in
Below 1 Ω
A42-3 - A42-4
Switch is not pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
A42
I044055E05
OK
BC
NG
REPLACE AUTO LSD SWITCH
BC–198
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - AUTO LSD SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
AUTO LSD Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
A42
I045574E03
OK
END
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
S28-43 (CSW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A42-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
CSW
BC
Tester Connection
S28-43 (CSW) - A42-3
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–199
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
AUTO LSD Indicator Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
Engaging the AUTO LSD switch causes the AUTO LSD indicator light to come on when the AUTO LSD is
ready (See page BC-6).
The AUTO LSD will not operate even if the AUTO LSD switch is pressed under the following conditions:
• TRAC and VSC system is faulty.
• Temperature inside the hydraulic brake booster increases and the AUTO LSD is halted.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Master Cylinder Solenoid
15
17
S28
INFR
AUTO LSD
BC
GAUGE
15
from Ignition Switch
AUTO LSD Switch
4
3
43
S28
CSW
C132929E09
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
INSPECT AUTO LSD INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Ground terminal INFR of the skid control ECU.
BC–200
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Check that the AUTO LSD indicator light comes on.
OK:
AUTO LSD indicator light comes on.
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the combination meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-15 (INFR) - C10-17
Below 1 Ω
S28-15 (INFR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S28
INFR
NG
Combination Meter (Right Side of the Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC
C10-17
I045338E24
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the combination meter system (see page ME-4).
NG
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
BC–201
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU (CSW TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
S28
Tester connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S28-43 (CSW) - Body
ground
Auto LSD switch is
pushed in
Below 1 Ω
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
CSW
C121700E94
NG
5
INSPECT AUTO LSD SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the AUTO LSD switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Momentary Type:
Not
Pushed in
Pushed in
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A42-3 - A42-4
Switch is pushed in
Below 1 Ω
A42-3 - A42-4
Switch is not pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
A42
I044055E05
OK
BC
NG
REPLACE AUTO LSD SWITCH
BC–202
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - AUTO LSD SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
CSW
AUTO LSD Switch Harness Side
Connector Front View:
A42
I045574E04
OK
END
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
S28-43 (CSW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A42-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
S28
BC
Tester Connection
S28-43 (CSW) - A42-3
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–203
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Skid Control Buzzer Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The skid control buzzer sounds while the accumulator pressure is abnormally low or an abnormality
causing low fluid pressure occurs, and then VSC is activated.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
Skid Control Buzzer
ECU-IG
2
1
30
S28
BZ
from Ignition Switch
BC
C132930E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (SKID CONTROL BUZZER)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Select "ACTIVE TEST" mode on the intelligent tester.
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
VSC / BR WARN BUZ
Turns skid control buzzer ON /OFF
Diagnostic note
Buzzer can be heard
(d) Check that the buzzer sounds/stops when turning the
skid control buzzer on/off by using the intelligent tester.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Buzzer sounds/stops
A
Buzzer does not sound or sounds constantly
B
A
END
BC–204
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
B
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL BUZZER (POWER SOURCE TERMINAL)
(a) Disconnect the skid control buzzer connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Skid Control Buzzer Harness Side
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V5-2 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
V5
I044040E05
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
OK
3
BC
INSPECT SKID CONTROL BUZZER
2
1
(+)
(-)
(a) Apply battery negative voltage to terminal 1, and battery
positive voltage to terminal 2 of the skid control buzzer,
and then check that the buzzer sounds.
OK:
Skid control buzzer sounds.
NG
F002192E15
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL BUZZER
BC–205
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL BUZZER - SKID CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Front View:
BZ
S28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S28-30 (BZ) - V5-1
Below 1 Ω
S28-30 (BZ) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Skid Control Buzzer Harness Side
Connector Front View:
V5
C124803E04
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
BC–206
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
DTC output mode is set by connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
The DTCs are displayed by blinking the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights.
WIRING DIAGRAM
DLC3
Master Cylinder Solenoid
ECM
CANH
TC
13
23
TC
CANL
BC
CG
33
34
11
S28
CANH
25
S28
CANL
4
C114570E05
HINT:
When each warning light stays blinking, a ground short in the wiring of terminal TC of the DLC3 or an
internal ground short in each ECU is suspected.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
1
DLC3:
INSPECT DLC3 (DLC3 (TC) - DLC3 (CG))
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
D1
OK
NG
TC
F100115E45
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-13 (TC) - D1-4 (CG)
10 to 14 V
Go to step 4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
2
BC–207
CHECK DTC (FOR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM)
(a) Check for CAN communication system DTC.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
3
DLC3:
CHECK ECM (DLC3 (TC) INPUT)
(a) Using SST, connect terminal TC and CG of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(b) Check if the engine warning light is blinking.
OK:
Engine warning light is blinking.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
NG
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
D1
TC
F100115E45
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPLACE ECM
BC
BC–208
4
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - DLC3 (TC))
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Disconnect the ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
ECM Harness View:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-23 (TC) - D1-13 (TC)
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
E8-23 (TC)
BC
DLC3:
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
D1
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
C140803E04
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 (CG) - BODY GROUND)
DLC3:
D1
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NG
CG
F100115E46
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
6
BC–209
CHECK ECM (DLC3 (TC) INPUT)
DLC3:
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
(b) Check if the engine warning light is blinking.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
D1
TC
F100115E45
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Engine warning light is blinking
A
Engine warning light is not blinking
B
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS OR
ECM (TC AND/OR ECM CIRCUIT)
A
7
BC
CHECK DTC (FOR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM)
(a) Check for CAN communication system DTC.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPAIR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
BC–210
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
TS and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The signal check circuit detects trouble in the sensor or switch signal which cannot be detected by the
DTC check.
Connecting terminals TS and CG of the DLC3 starts the check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Master Cylinder Solenoid
DLC3
TS
BC
CG
12
24
S28
TS
4
C114571E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, perform zero point calibration (See page BC-20).
BC–211
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - DLC3 (TS))
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Skid Control ECU Harness Side
Connector Fornt View:
NG
S28
TS
Tester Connection
Specified condition
S28-24 (TS) - D1-12 (TS)
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
DLC3:
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
D1
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
BC
C124792E05
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY GROUND - DLC3 (CG))
DLC3:
D1
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NG
CG
F100115E46
OK
Tester Connection
Specified condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–212
3
DLC3:
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY GROUND - DLC3 (TS))
TS
D1
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NG
F100115E47
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
BC
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-12 (TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
BC–35
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If there are no DTCs output but the problem still occurs,
check the circuits for each problem symptom in the order
given in the table below and proceed to the relevant
troubleshooting page.
NOTICE:
When replacing the master cylinder solenoid, sensor,
etc., turn the ignition switch off.
VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
ABS, BA and/or EBD does not operate
ABS, BA and/or EBD does not operate efficiently
VSC and/or TRAC does not operate
Sensor and switch signal check cannot be done
DTC check cannot be performed
ABS warning light abnormal (Remains on)
ABS warning light abnormal (Does not come on)
VSC TRAC warning light abnormal (Remains on)
Suspected Area
See page
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
system code is output.
BC-39
2. IG power source circuit
BC-94
3. Front speed sensor circuit
BC-53
4. Rear speed sensor circuit
BC-62
5. Check the hydraulic brake booster using intelligent tester. If
abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
BR-17
6. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits in
suspected areas are inspected and proved to be normal,
replace the master cylinder solenoid.
BR-25
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
system code is output.
BC-39
2. Front speed sensor circuit
BC-53
3. Rear speed sensor circuit
BC-62
4. Stop light switch circuit
BC-104
5. Check the hydraulic brake booster using intelligent tester. If
abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
BR-17
6. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits in
suspected areas are inspected and proved to be normal,
replace the master cylinder solenoid.
BR-25
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
system code is output.
BC-39
2. IG power source circuit
BC-94
3. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
-
4. Front speed sensor circuit
BC-53
5. Rear speed sensor circuit
BC-62
6. Yaw rate and acceleration sensor circuit
BC-91
7. Steering angle sensor circuit
BC-88
8. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits in
suspected areas are inspected and proved to be normal,
replace the master cylinder solenoid.
BR-25
1. TS and CG terminal circuit
BC-207
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
system code is output.
BC-39
2. TC and CG terminal circuit
BC-203
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits in
suspected areas are inspected and proved to be normal,
replace the master cylinder solenoid.
BR-25
1. ABS warning light circuit
BC-157
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. ABS warning light circuit
BC-161
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. VSC TRAC warning light circuit
BC-163
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
BC
BC–36
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
VSC TRAC warning light abnormal (Does not come
on)
BRAKE warning light abnormal (Remains on)
BRAKE warning light abnormal (Does not come on)
VSC OFF indicator light abnormal (Remains on) (*2)
VSC OFF indicator light abnormal (Does not come on)
(*2)
AUTO LSD indicator light abnormal (Remains on) (*1)
AUTO LSD indicator light abnormal (Does not come
on) (*1)
Downhill assist control indicator light abnormal
(Remains on) (*3)
BC
Downhill assist control indicator light abnormal (Does
not come on) (*3)
SLIP indicator light abnormal (Remains on)
SLIP indicator light abnormal (Does not come on)
Skid control buzzer abnormal
Suspected Area
See page
1. VSC TRAC warning light circuit
BC-165
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. BRAKE warning light circuit
BC-167
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. BRAKE warning light circuit
BC-172
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. 4WD control (4WD) switch circuit (*3)
BC-126
2. VSC OFF indicator light circuit
BC-175
3. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. 4WD control (4WD) switch circuit (*3)
BC-126
2. VSC OFF indicator light circuit
BC-178
3. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. AUTO LSD indicator light circuit
BC-192
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. AUTO LSD indicator light circuit
BC-196
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. 4WD control (L4) switch circuit
BC-132
2. 4WD control (4WD) switch circuit
BC-126
3. Downhill assist control indicator light circuit
BC-184
4. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. 4WD control (L4) switch circuit
BC-132
2. 4WD control (4WD) switch circuit
BC-126
3. Downhill assist control indicator light circuit
BC-188
4. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. SLIP indicator light circuit
BC-180
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. SLIP indicator light circuit
BC-182
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
1. Skid control buzzer circuit
BC-200
2. Master cylinder solenoid
BR-25
(*1): 2WD (*2): 4WD (*3): Multi Mode 4WD
BC–216
BRAKE CONTROL – YAW RATE AND ACCELERATION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
2.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
(See page IP-7)
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR (See
page IP-9)
6.
REMOVE YAWRATE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the yawrate sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and yawrate sensor.
F043114
BC
INSTALLATION
F043114
1.
INSTALL YAWRATE SENSOR
(a) Install the yawrate sensor with 2 bolts.
Torque: 13.3 N*m (136 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the yawrate sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
3.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
4.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
5.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
6.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
7.
PERFORM YAWRATE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION
HINT:
(See page BC-20)
8.
CHECK VSC SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
BRAKE CONTROL – STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BC–217
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
STEERING WHEEL COVER
LOWER NO. 2
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
HORN BUTTON
ASSEMBLY
TURN SIGNAL
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
STEERING WHEEL COVER
LOWER NO. 3
BC
STEERING SENSOR
STEERING COLUMN
COVER UPR
C131331E04
BC–218
BRAKE CONTROL – STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION (See page SR-8)
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
3.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
6.
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSEMBLY (See page SR8)
7.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-9)
8.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
9.
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-9)
10. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (See
page SR-10)
11. REMOVE STEERING SENSOR
(a) Remove the steering sensor connector.
BC
C088509
(b) Remove the 2 claws, then remove the steering
sensor.
C088506
INSTALLATION
1.
C088506
INSTALL STEERING SENSOR
(a) Install the steering sensor.
BRAKE CONTROL – STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BC–219
(b) Install the steering sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (See
page SR-21)
3.
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-398)
4.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
5.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-21)
6.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR (See
page SR-21)
7.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-21)
8.
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSEMBLY (See page SR21)
9.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
C088509
10. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
11. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page SR-22)
12. PERFORM STEERING ANGLE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION
BC-20
13. CHECK VSC SENSOR SIGNAL
BC-23
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–37
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
TERMINALS OF ECU
Skid Control ECU:
C110610E05
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
GND1 (1)
Skid control ECU ground
+BM1 (2)
Power supply for motor
FR+ (3)
Front RH wheel speed sensor power supply output
FL- (4)
Front LH wheel speed sensor input
RR+ (5)
Rear RH wheel speed sensor power supply output
RL- (6)
Rear LH wheel speed sensor input
STP (7)
Stop light switch input
NEO (10) (*2)
Center diff. lock indicator light input
CANH (11)
CAN communication line H
SP1 (12)
Speed signal output to combination meter
D/G (13)
Diagnosis tester communication line
P (14)
Shift position indicator P signal input
INFR (15) (*1)
AUTO LSD indicator light output
STPO (16)
Stop light operation relay output
FR- (17)
Front RH wheel speed sensor input
FL+ (18)
Front LH wheel speed sensor power supply output
RR- (19)
Rear RH wheel speed sensor input
RL+ (20)
Rear LH wheel speed sensor power supply output
*2)
EXI4 (21) (
4WD control (L4) switch input
TS (24)
Sensor test terminal (Signal check switch) input
CANL (25)
CAN communication line L
EXI3 (26) (*2)
ADD (Auto disconnected differential lock) change over actuator switch
input (*3) Ground (*4)
EXI (27) (*2)
Center diff. lock switch input
PKB (28)
Parking brake switch input
WA (29)
ABS warning light output
BZ (30)
Skid control buzzer output
+BS (31)
Power supply for solenoid
GND2 (32)
*
HDCW (33) ( 3)
IND (34)
Skid control ECU ground
Downhill assist control indicator light output
SLIP indicator light output
*2)
VSC OFF indicator light output
VSCW (36)
VSC TRAC warning light output
FRO (37)
Front RH wheel speed output
FLO (38)
Front LH wheel speed output
LBL (41)
Brake fluid level warning switch input
WT (35) (
BC
BC–38
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
WFSE (42)
Write flash enable input
CSW (43) (*1)
AUTO LSD switch input
*3)
Downhill assist control switch input
HDCS (44) (
STP2 (45)
Stop light switch input
IG1 (46)
IG1 power supply
Skid Control ECU:
C124763E02
BC
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
IG2 (1)
IG2 Power supply
+BM2 (2)
Power supply for motor
BRL (3)
BRAKE warning light output
GND3 (4)
Skid control ECU ground
2.
(*1): 2WD
(*2): 4WD
(*3): Multi Mode 4WD
(*4): Full Time 4WD
TERMINAL INSPECTION
Disconnect the connector and measure the voltage or
resistance on the wire harness side.
HINT:
Voltage cannot be measured with the connector
connected to the skid control ECU as the connector is
water resistance.
Skid Control ECU Harness Side Connector
Front View:
S28
S29
C124764E04
BC–39
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring
Color
Terminal Description
+BM1 (S28-2) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
Y-B - W-B
Power supply for motor
(From battery)
STP (S28-7) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
G-B - W-B
Stop light switch input
P (S28-14) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
G-B - W-B
PKB (S28-28) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
Specified
Condition
Condition
Always
10 to 14 V
Stop light switch ON → OFF (Brake
pedal depressed → released)
8 to 14 V → Below
1.5 V
Shift position indicator P
signal input
Ignition switch ON, shift P position → any
shift position except P
8 to 14 V → Below
1.5 V
LG - W-B
Parking brake switch input
Ignition switch ON, parking brake switch
ON → OFF
Below 1.5 V → 10
to 14 V
+BS (S28-31) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
Y - W-B
Power supply for solenoid
(From battery)
Always
LBL (S28-41) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
LG - W-B
Brake fluid level warning
switch input
STP2 (S28-45) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
G-Y - W-B
Stop light switch input
IG1 (S28-46) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
B-R - W-B
IG2 (S29-1) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
+BM2 (S29-2) - GND (S28-1, 32)
(S29-4)
10 to 14 V
Brake fluid level is - 5 mm from the
minimum level → maximum level
Below 1 Ω → 1.9 to
2.1 kΩ
Stop light switch ON → OFF
(Brake pedal depressed → released)
8 to 14 V → Below
1.5 V
IG1 power supply
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Below 1 V → 10 to
14 V
B-O - W-B
IG2 power supply
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Below 1 V → 10 to
14 V
Y-B - W-B
Power supply for motor
(From battery)
Always
10 to 14 V
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
ABS Warning Light
BRAKE Warning Light
USA:
USA/Canada:
Canada/Mexico:
Mexico:
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
VSC OFF Indicator Light
SLIP Indicator Light
AUTO LSD Indicator Light
1.
DIAGNOSIS
(a) If the skid control ECU detects a malfunction, the
ABS, BRAKE, VSC TRAC warning lights and the
VSC OFF, SLIP, downhill assist control indicator
lights will come on to warn the driver.
The table below indicates which lights will come on
when there is a malfunction in a particular function.
Downhill Assist Control Indicator Light
I042827E02
Item /
Trouble
Area
ABS
EBD
BA
VSC
ABS
Warning
Light
{
{
{
-
TRAC
A-TRAC
(4WD)
-
-
AUTO LSD
Downhill
assist
control
(4WD)
Hill-start
assist
control
-
-
-
BC
BC–40
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Item /
Trouble
Area
ABS
EBD
BA
VSC
TRAC
A-TRAC
(4WD)
AUTO LSD
Downhill
assist
control
(4WD)
Hill-start
assist
control
BRAKE
Warning
Light
-
{
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
VSC TARC
Warning
Light
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
VSC OFF
Indicator
Light (4WD)
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
SLIP
Indicator
Light
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
AUTO LSD
Indicator
Light
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Downhill
assist
control
Indicator
Light (4WD)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
z
(Downhill
assist
control
switch ON)
{: Light ON z: Light ON (Blinking) -: Light OFF
• The DTCs are simultaneously stored in the memory. The
DTCs can be read by connecting the SST between
terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 and observing the
blinking of the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights, or by
connecting the intelligent tester.
• This system has a signal check function (test mode). The
DTC can be read by connecting the intelligent tester and
observing the blinking of the ABS and VSC TRAC warning
lights.
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
ABS Warning Light
BRAKE Warning Light
USA:
USA/Canada:
Canada/Mexico:
Mexico:
VSC TRAC
Warning Light
VSC OFF Indicator Light
SLIP Indicator Light
AUTO LSD Indicator Light
Downhill Assist Control Indicator Light
WARNING LIGHT AND INDICATOR LIGHT BULB
CHECK
(a) Release the parking brake lever.
NOTICE:
When releasing the parking brake, set the
chocks to hold the vehicle for safety.
HINT:
When the parking brake is applied or the level of the
brake fluid is low, the BRAKE warning light comes
on.
(b) When the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position, check that the ABS, BRAKE, and VSC
TRAC warning lights and the VSC OFF, SLIP, AUTO
LSD, and downhill assist control indicator lights
come on for approximately 3 seconds.
HINT:
If the warning light and indicator light check result is
not normal, proceed to troubleshooting for the ABS,
BRAKE, and VSC TRAC warning light circuits, and
the VSC OFF, SLIP, AUTO LSD, and downhill assist
control indicator light circuits.
If the indicator remains on, proceed to
troubleshooting for the light circuit below.
Trouble area
I042827E02
DLC3:
See procedure
ABS warning light circuit
BC-157
BRAKE warning light circuit
BC-167
VSC TRAC warning light circuit
BC-163
VSC OFF indicator light circuit
BC-175
SLIP indicator light circuit
BC-180
AUTO LSD indicator light circuit
BC-192
Downhill assist control indicator light circuit
BC-184
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
CG
1.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
BC–41
F100115E49
DTC CHECK / CLEAR (SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) DTC check
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Read the DTCs from the ABS and VSC TRAC
warning lights on the combination meter.
HINT:
• If no code appears, inspect the TC and CG
terminal circuit, and the ABS and VSC TRAC
warning light circuits.
Trouble Area
TC and CG terminal circuit
See procedure
BC-203
ABS warning light circuit
BC-157 or BC-161
VSC TRAC warning light circuit
BC-163 or BC-165
• As examples, refer to the chart below for the
blinking patterns of the normal system code
and trouble codes 11 and 21.
BC
BC–42
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Normal System Code:
Trouble Code (Example Codes 11 and 21):
2.5 sec.
0.25 sec.
2 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
4 sec.
Code 11
Repeat
Code 21
F100113E04
BC
(4) Codes are explained in the code table (See
page BC-48).
(5) After completing the check, disconnect terminals
TC and CG of the DLC3, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more DTCs are detected at the same
time, the DTCs will be displayed in ascending
order.
DLC3:
(b) DTC clear
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
F100115E02
BR03890
(3) Clear the DTCs stored in the ECU by depressing
the brake pedal 8 times or more within 5
seconds.
(4) check that the warning light indicates the normal
system code.
(5) Remove the SST from the terminals of the
DLC3.
HINT:
Clearing the DTCs cannot be performed by
removing the battery cable or the ECU-IG fuse.
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
2.
DLC3
I042828E01
3.
BC–43
DTC CHECK / CLEAR (INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(a) DTC check
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Read the DTCs following the prompts on the
tester screen.
(b) DTC clear
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Operate the intelligent tester to clear the codes.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
END OF DTC CHECK / CLEAR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position
(b) Check that the ABS and VSC TRAC warning lights
go off within approximately 3 seconds.
BC
BC–44
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
FREEZE FRAME DATA
1.
BC
Item (Display)
FREEZE FRAME DATA
(a) Whenever a DTC is detected or the ABS operates,
the skid control ECU stores the current vehicle
(sensor) state as freeze frame data.
The skid control ECU stores the number of times
(maximum: 31) the ignition switch has been turned
from off to the ON position since the last time the
ABS was activated.
HINT:
• However, if the vehicle was stopped or at low
speed (4.3 mph (7 km/h) or less), or if a DTC is
detected, the skid control ECU will not count the
number since then.
• Freeze frame data at the time the ABS operates:
The skid control ECU stores and updates data
whenever the ABS system operates. When the
ECU stores data at the time a DTC is detected,
the data stored when the ABS operated is
erased.
• Freeze frame data at the time a DTC is detected:
When the skid control ECU stores data at the
time a DTC is detected, no updates will be
performed until the data is cleared.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) On the tester display, select the freeze frame data.
Measurement Item
Reference Value
TROUBLE CODE
Freeze DTC
0 to 65535
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch signal
Stop light switch ON: ON, OFF: OFF
Shift lever position
FAIL
P, N
R
D/M
4
3
2
L
SYSTEM
System status
ABS activated: ABS
VSC/TRAC activated: VSC/TRAC
BA activated: BA
No system activated: NO SYS
# IG ON
Number of operations of ignition switch ON
after memorizing freeze frame data
0 to 31
Vehicle speed reading
Min.: 0 km/h, Max.: 326.4 km/h
Steering angle sensor reading
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Drop
Yaw rate sensor reading
Min.: -128 deg/s, Max.: 127 deg/s
MAS CYL PRESS
Master cylinder pressure sensor reading
Brake pedal released: 0.3 to 0.9 V
Brake pedal depressed: 0.8 to 4.5 V
MAS PRESS GRADE
SHIFT POSITION
VEHICLE SPD
STEERING ANG
YAW RATE
Master cylinder pressure sensor change
Min.: -30 MPa/s, Max.: 255 MPa/s
G (RIGHT & LEFT)
Right and left G
Min.: -1.869 G, Max.: 1.869 G
G (BACK & FORTH)
Back and forth G
Min.: -1.869 G, Max.: 1.869 G
Front right wheel direction signal
Front right wheel direction
FORWARD: Forward, BACK: Back
WHEEL DIR FR
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Item (Display)
Measurement Item
BC–45
Reference Value
WHEEL DIR FL
Front left wheel direction signal
Front left wheel direction
FORWARD: Forward, BACK: Back
WHEEL DIR RR
Rear right wheel direction signal
Rear right wheel direction
FORWARD: Forward, BACK: Back
WHEEL DIR RL
Rear left wheel direction signal
Rear left wheel direction
FORWARD: Forward, BACK: Back
THROTTLE
Throttle position sensor reading
Accelerator pedal released: approx. 0%
Accelerator pedal depressed: approx. 100%
Skid control buzzer signal
Skid control buzzer ON: ON, OFF: OFF
Brake fluid level warning switch signal
Brake fluid level warning switch ON: ON,
OFF: OFF
Parking brake switch signal
Parking brake switch ON: ON, OFF: OFF
BUZZER
RESERVOIR SW
PKB SW
BC
BC–46
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
BC
Malfunction Area
FAIL SAFE OPERATION
• If there is a problem with sensor signals or actuator
systems, the skid control ECU prohibits power supply
to the brake actuator and informs the ECM of VSC
system failure.
The brake actuator turns off each solenoid and the
ECM shuts off VSC control (traction control signal)
from the skid control ECU accordingly, which turns out
to be as if the ABS, TRAC and VSC systems were not
installed.
The ABS control will be prohibited, but EBD control
continues as much as possible. If EBD control is
impossible, the BRAKE warning light comes on to
warn the driver (See page BC-38).
• If system components have any malfunction before
starting control, immediately stop the operation.
If system components have any malfunction during
control, gradually stop the control so as not to trigger
a sudden change in vehicle conditions.
If it is impossible to control the systems, the warning
light comes on to inform the driver of termination of
the systems (See page BC-38).
HINT:
If the hydraulic brake booster encounters a malfunction,
brake performance is gradually lost and ABS, BA, TRAC,
A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control and
hill-start assist control system control is prohibited.
(a) ABS, EBD and BA system:
HINT:
A malfunction in either the ABS or BA system will
result in an identical operation, with ABS, BA,
TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist
control and hill-start assist control system control
prohibited.
Control Method
ABS system
ABS, BA, TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control and hill-start
assist control control is prohibited
BA system
ABS, BA, TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control and hill-start
assist control control is prohibited
EBD system
ABS, EBD, BA, TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control and hillstart assist control control is prohibited
(b) TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist
control and hill-start assist control system:
HINT:
As for the TRAC, A-TRAC, VSC, AUTO LSD,
downhill assist control and hill-start assist control
systems, different systems prohibit different controls
according to a malfunctioning part.
Malfunction Area
Engine control system
(TRAC, A-TRAC and VSC systems)
Control Method
Before control: Disables control
During control: Uses only brakes to effect control
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Malfunction Area
BC–47
Control Method
Brake control system
(VSC system)
Before control: Disables control
During control: Uses only engine to effect control
Brake control system
(TRAC, A-TRAC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist control
and hill-start assist control system)
Brake control: Disables control
During control: Disables control (by gradually ending control)
2.
System
SYSTEM TEMPERATURE PROTECTION OPERATION
If the TRAC, A-TRAC, AUTO LSD, downhill assist
control, or hill-start assist control system has been used
constantly for a long time, the temperature of the brake
actuator, built in the hydraulic brake booster, may
excessively increase. If the temperature excessively
increases, the skid control buzzer will sound
intermittently. If the temperature increases more, the skid
control buzzer sounds for 3 seconds and the indicator
light either comes on or blinks.
Indicator Condition
TRAC, A-TRAC, AUTO LSD and hill-start assist control systems
SLIP indicator light comes on
Downhill assist control system
SLIP indicator light comes on
Downhill assist control indicator light blinks
HINT:
• If the SLIP indicator light goes off (as for the downhill
assist control system, the downhill assist control
indicator light also comes on), the systems
automatically return to normal operating conditions.
• As this is not a malfunction, no DTC will be recorded.
BC
BC–48
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
Item
BC
DATA LIST
HINT:
While the intelligent tester is connected to the DLC3 with
the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the ABS,
TRAC and VSC data list can be displayed. Follow the
prompts on the tester screen to access the "DATA LIST".
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
HB MOT RELAY
HB motor relay / ON or OFF
ON : During pump motor
operation
OFF : No pump motor operation
-
SOL RELAY
Solenoid relay / ON or OFF
ON : Solenoid relay ON
OFF : Solenoid relay OFF
-
IDLE SW
Main idle switch / ON or OFF
ON : Accelerator pedal released
OFF : Accelerator pedal
depressed
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch / ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
PKB SW
Parking brake switch / ON or OFF
ON : Parking brake applied
OFF : Parking brake released
-
RESERVOIR SW
Brake fluid level warning switch /
ON or OFF
ON : Switch ON
OFF : Switch OFF
-
AIR BLD SUPPORT
Air bleed availability / SUPPORT
or NOT SUP
SUPPORT: Support ON
NOT SUP: Support OFF
-
ABS OPERT FR
ABS operation (FR) / BEFORE or
OPERATE
BEFORE : No ABS operation
(FR)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (FR)
-
ABS OPERT FL
ABS operation (FL) / BEFORE or
OPERATE
BEFORE : No ABS operation (FL)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (FL)
-
ABS OPERT RR
ABS operation (RR) / BEFORE or
OPERATE
BEFORE : No ABS operation
(RR)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (RR)
-
ABS OPERT RL
ABS operation (RL) / BEFORE or
OPERATE
BEFORE : No ABS operation
(RL)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (RL)
-
WHEEL SPD FR
Wheel speed sensor (FR) reading
/ Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h), Max.: 202
mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD FL
Wheel speed sensor (FL) reading
/ Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h), Max.: 202
mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD RR
Wheel speed sensor (RR)
reading / Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h),
Max.: 202 mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD RL
Wheel speed sensor (RL) reading
/ Min.: 0 mph (0 km/h), Max.: 202
mph (326 km/h)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
DECELERAT SEN
Acceleration sensor 1 reading /
Min.: -1.869 G, Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +- 0.13G while
stationary
Reading changes when vehicle is
bounced
DECELERAT SEN2
Acceleration sensor 2 reading /
Min.: -1.869 G, Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +- 0.13G while
stationary
Reading changes when vehicle is
bounced
IG VOLTAGE
ECU IG power supply voltage /
TOO LOW / NORMAL / TOO
HIGH
TOO LOW: 9.5 V or less
NORMAL: 9.5 V or 14.0 V
TOO HIGH: 14.0 V or more
-
BC–49
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SFRR
ABS solenoid (SFRR) / ON or
OFF
ON: Operates
-
SFRH
ABS solenoid (SFRH) / ON or
OFF
ON: Operates
-
SFLR
ABS solenoid (SFLR) / ON or
OFF
ON: Operates
-
SFLH
ABS solenoid (SFLH) / ON or
OFF
ON: Operates
-
SRRR (SRR)
ABS solenoid (SRRR [SRR]) / ON
or OFF
ON: Operates
-
SRRH (SRH)
ABS solenoid (SRRH [SRH]) / ON
or OFF
ON: Operates
-
SRLR
ABS solenoid (SRLR) / ON or
OFF
ON: Operates
-
SRLH
ABS solenoid (SRLH) / ON or
OFF
ON: Operates
-
SRCF (SA1)
TRAC solenoid (SMCF) / ON or
OFF
-
-
SRCR (SA2)
TRAC solenoid (SREA) / ON or
OFF
-
-
SRMF (SMCF, SA3)
TRAC solenoid (SREC) / ON or
OFF
-
-
SRMR (SMCR, STR)
TRAC solenoid (STR) / ON or
OFF
-
-
ECU CODE #4
ECU CODE
1 or 0
0
ECU CODE #3
ECU CODE
1 or 0
0
ECU CODE #2
ECU CODE
1 or 0
0
ECU CODE #1
ECU CODE
1 or 0
0
ENGINE SPD
Engine Speed/ Min.: 0 rpm, Max.:
6000 rpm
Actual engine speed
-
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed reading / Min.: 0
mph (0 km/h), Max.: 202 mph
(326 km/h)
Actual engine speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
YAW RATE
Yaw rate sensor/ Min.: -128 deg/
s, Max.: 127 deg/s
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 127 deg/s
-
YAW ZERO VALUE
Memorized zero value/ Min.: -128
deg/s, Max.: 127 deg/s
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 127 deg/s
-
STEERING ANG
Steering angle sensor/ Min.: 1152 deg/s, Max.: 1150.875 deg/s
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
-
MAS CYL PRESS 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 reading / Min.: 0V, Max.: 5V
When brake pedal is released :
0.3 to 0.9 V
When stop light is turned on: 0.3
to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
ACC PRESS
Accumulator pressure sensor /
Min.: 0V, Max.: 5V
3.58 to 5 V
If the value is constant regardless
of pump operation, accumulator
pressure sensor malfunction is
suspected.
WHEEL DIR FR
Wheel direction (FR) /
FORWARD or BACK
BACK: Back, FORWARD:
Forward
-
WHEEL DIR FL
Wheel direction (FL) / FORWARD
or BACK
BACK: Back, FORWARD:
Forward
-
WHEEL DIR RR
Wheel direction (RR) /
FORWARD or BACK
BACK: Back, FORWARD:
Forward
-
WHEEL DIR RL
Wheel direction (RL) /
FORWARD or BACK
BACK: Back, FORWARD:
Forward
-
BC
BC–50
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Item
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN FR
Speed sensor open detection
(FR)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN FL
Speed sensor open detection
(FL)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN RR
Speed sensor open detection
(RR)/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
SPD SEN RL
Speed sensor open detection
(RL/OPN DET or NORMAL
OPN DET: Momentary
interruption
NORMAL: Normal
-
ACCELERATOR %
The difference of a present
accelerator / Min.: 0%, Max.:
128%
-
-
TORQUE
Real output torque /Min.: -1024
Nm, Max.: 1016 Nm
-
-
TEST MODE
Test mode operation / NORMAL
or TEST
NORMAL: Normal mode
TEST: During test mode
-
MAS CYL PRESS 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 reading / min.: 0V, max.: 5V
When brake pedal released: 0.3
to 0.9V
#CODES
Number of DTC recorded / Min.:
0, Max.: 255
-
2.
BC
Item
Reading increases when brake
pedal depressed
-
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows the relay, actuator, etc. to operate without
removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
the first step of troubleshooting is one of the methods to
shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) According to the display on the tester, perform the
"ACTIVE TEST".
HINT:
The ignition switch must be turned to the ON
position to proceed to the ACTIVE TEST using the
intelligent tester.
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SFRR
Turns ABS solenoid (SFRR) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SFRH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFRH) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SFLR
Turns ABS solenoid (SFLR) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SFLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFLH) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRRR
Turns ABS solenoid (SRRR) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRRH
Turns ABS solenoid (SRRH) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRLR
Turns ABS solenoid (SRLR) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
BRAKE CONTROL – VEHICLE STABILITY CONTROL SYSTEM
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
BC–51
Diagnostic Note
SRLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFLH) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRCF (SA1)
Turns TRAC solenoid (SMCF) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRCR (SA2)
Turns TRAC solenoid (SREA) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRMF (SMCF, SA3)
Turns TRAC solenoid (SREC) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRMR (SMCR, STR)
Turns TRAC solenoid (STR) ON / OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SFRR & SFRH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFRR and SFRH) ON /
OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SFLR & SFLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFLR and SFLH) ON /
OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRH & SRR
Turns ABS solenoid (SRRH and SRRR) ON /
OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRLR & SRLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SRLR and SRLH) ON /
OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SFRH & SFLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFRH and SFLH) ON /
OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRCF & SRCR
Turns TRAC solenoid (SMCF and SREA) ON
/ OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
SRMF & SRMR
Turns TRAC solenoid (SREC and STR) ON /
OFF
Operation sound of solenoid (clicking sound)
can be heard
ABS WARN LIGHT
Turns ABS warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
VSC WARN LIGHT
Turns VSC TRAC warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
VSC / TRC OFF IND
Turns VSC OFF indicator light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
SLIP INDI LIGHT
Turn SLIP indicator light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
BRAKE WRN LIGHT
Turns BRAKE warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
VSC / BR WARN BUZ
Turns skid control buzzer ON / OFF
Buzzer can be heard
H/B MOT RELAY
Turns H/B motor relay ON / OFF
Operation sound of motor can be heard
STOP LIGHT RELAY
Turns stop light operation relay ON / OFF
Observe rear combination light
(Does not come on for 5 sec. or more
BC
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BR–7
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE (See
page IP-6)
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH (See
page IP-8)
4.
REMOVE PUSH ROD PIN
(a) Remove the clip and push rod pin from the brake
pedal lever.
5.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT
REINFORCEMENT
(a) Remove the bolt from the brake pedal support
reinforcement.
F043151
(b) Remove the bolt and nut, then remove the brake
pedal support reinforcement from brake pedal
support sub-assembly.
6.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the stop light switch connector from the
stop light switch assembly.
F043115
(b) Remove the 4 nuts and brake pedal support subassembly.
F043116
7.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
8.
REMOVE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the stop light switch assembly
counterclockwise and remove the stop light switch
assembly.
(b) Remove the cushion from brake pedal support subassembly.
BR
BR–8
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
9.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and nut, then remove the brake
pedal sub-assembly from brake pedal support subassembly.
(b) Remove the 4 brake pedal bushes from the brake
pedal and brake pedal lever.
(c) Remove the 2 collars from brake pedal subassembly and brake pedal lever.
F043117
DISASSEMBLY
F043118E01
1.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL LEVER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 E-rings from the
brake pedal link pin.
(b) Remove the 2 brake pedal link pins, 2 brake pedal
shaft collars and 2 brake pedal link.
(c) Remove the brake pedal lever from brake pedal
sub-assembly.
2.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL PAD
(a) Remove the brake pedal pad from the brake pedal
sub-assembly.
ADJUSTMENT
Rod Operating
Adapter
BR
Stop Light
Switch Assembly
Pedal Height
F043109E02
1.
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT
(a) Check the brake pedal height.
Pedal height from dash panel:
166.1 to 176.1 mm (6.539 to 6.933 in.)
NOTICE:
Do not adjust the pedal height. Doing so by
changing the push rod length will structurally
change the pedal ratio.
If the pedal height is incorrect, adjust the rod
operating adapter length.
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
(b) Adjust the rod operating adapter length.
(1) Remove the clip and clevis pin.
(2) Loosen the clevis lock nut.
(3) Adjust the rod operating adapter length by
turning the pedal push rod clevis.
Rod operating adapter length "A":
232.5 to 242.5 mm (9.154 to 9.547 in.)
(4) Tighten the clevis lock nut.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
(5) Install the clip and clevis pin.
If the pedal height is incorrect even if the rod
operating adapter is adjusted, check that there
is no damage in brake pedal, brake pedal lever,
brake pedal bracket and dash panel.
• Even if there is damage, there is no problem
if the reserve distance is within the standard
value.
• If necessary, replace them.
A
Rod Operating
Adapter
Clevis
Lock Nut
2.
F044242E02
Cushion
Stop Light Switch Assembly
0.5 to 2.5 mm (0.020 to 0.098 in.)
F043108E12
BR–9
CHECK AND ADJUST STOP LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
HINT:
If the pedal height is incorrect, check and adjust the stop
light switch clearance.
(a) Disconnect the stop light switch assembly connector
from the stop light switch assembly.
(b) Turn the stop light switch assembly
counterclockwise and remove the stop light switch
assembly.
(c) Insert the stop light switch assembly until the body
hits the cushion.
NOTICE:
When inserting the stop light switch assembly,
support the pedal from behind so that the pedal
is not pushed in.
(d) Make a quarter turn clockwise to install the stop light
switch assembly.
NOTICE:
The turning torque for installing the stop light
switch assembly.
HINT:
Due to the inverse screw structure, if the stop light
switch assembly is turned clockwise, the stop light
switch assembly moves in the direction to be pulled
out.
(e) Connect the stop light switch connector to the stop
light switch assembly.
(f) Check the protrusion of the rod.
Protrusion of the rod:
0.5 to 2.5 mm (0.020 to 0.098 in.)
(g) Install the clevis pin and clip.
(h) After adjusting the pedal height, check the pedal
free play.
BR
BR–10
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
3.
CHECK PEDAL FREE PLAY
(a) Stop the engine and depress the brake pedal
several times until there is no more vacuum left in
the booster.
(b) Push in the pedal until the beginning of the
resistance is felt. Measure the distance, as shown.
Pedal free play:
1 to 6 mm (0.04 to 0.24 in.)
4.
CHECK PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE
(a) Release the parking brake pedal.
With engine running, depress the pedal and
measure the pedal reserve distance, as shown.
Pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 490
N (50 kgf, 110.2 lbf):
More than 55 mm (2.17 in.)
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system.
Pedal Free Play
F043110E01
BR
Pedal Reserve
Distance
R000934E23
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BR–11
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL PAD
(a) Install the brake pedal pad to the brake pedal subassembly.
2.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL LEVER
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to the 2
brake pedal link pins, pedal shaft collars and 2
brake pedal link.
(b) Install the brake pedal lever with 2 brake pedal link
pins, 2 brake pedal shaft collars and 2 brake pedal
link to the brake pedal sub-assembly.
(c) Install the 2 new E-rings to each of brake pedal link
pin.
BR
BR–12
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to the 2
collars and 4 brake pedal bushes.
(b) Install the 2 collars and 4 brake pedal bushes to the
brake pedal sub-assembly and brake pedal lever.
(c) Install the brake pedal sub-assembly with the bolt
and nut to the brake pedal support sub-assembly.
Torque: 34.3 N*m (350 kgf*cm, 25 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the cushion to the brake pedal bracket.
F043117
Cushion
BR
(b) Insert the stop lamp switch assembly until the body
hits the cushion.
NOTICE:
When inserting the stop light switch, support
the pedal from behind so that the pedal is not
pushed in.
(c) Make a quarter turn clockwise to install the stop light
switch assembly.
NOTICE:
The turning torque for installing the stop light
switch assembly.
HINT:
Due to the inverse screw structure, if the stop light
switch assembly is turned clockwise, the stop light
switch assembly moves in the direction to be pulled
out.
Stop Light Switch Assembly
0.5 to 2.5 mm (0.020 to 0.098 in.)
F043108E12
F043116
3.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to inner
surface of the hole on the brake pedal support subassembly.
(b) Install the brake pedal return spring to the brake
pedal support sub-assembly.
4.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 4 nuts and brake pedal support subassembly.
Torque: 14.2 N*m (145 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the stop light switch connector to the stop
light switch assembly.
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
5.
BR–13
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT
REINFORCEMENT
(a) Install the brake pedal support reinforcement to the
brake pedal support sub-assembly.
(b) Temporarily tighten the bolt and nut to the brake
pedal support sub-assembly, brake pedal support
reinforcement and brake pedal lever.
F043115
(c) Install the bolt to the brake pedal support
reinforcement.
Torque: 34.3 N*m (350 kgf*cm, 25 ft.*lbf)
(d) Tighten the bolt and nut.
Torque: 34.3 N*m (350 kgf*cm, 25 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL PUSH ROD PIN
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to the
inner surface of the hole on the brake pedal lever.
(b) Install the push rod pin and clip to the brake pedal
lever.
7.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
8.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
9.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
F043151
10. CHECK BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT
HINT:
(See page BR-8)
11. CHECK PEDAL FREE PLAY
HINT:
(See page BR-8)
12. CHECK PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE
HINT:
(See page BR-8)
13. CHECK VSC SENSOR SIGNAL
HINT:
(See page BC-20)
BR
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–25
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
• When installing, coat the parts indicated by arrows
with lithium soap base glycol grease (See page BR13).
• As high pressure is applied to the brake actuator tube
No. 1, never deform it.
• Until the work is over, do not turn the ignition switch
to the ON position.
• Before starting the work, make sure that the ignition
switch is off and depress the brake pedal more than 20
times.
HINT:
When pressure in the power supply system is released,
reaction force becomes light and stroke becomes longer.
F051429E01
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
2.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash off brake fluid immediately if it comes into
contact with a painted surface.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
4.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
5.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
6.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE (See
page IP-6)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-7)
8.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
(a) Remove the 4 clips and steering column hole cover.
9.
REMOVE PUSH ROD PIN
(a) Remove the clip and push rod pin from the clevis.
BR
BR–26
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
10. REMOVE HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 3 connectors from the hydraulic
brake booster assembly.
F051438E02
To Right
Front Wheel
BR
To Right
Rear Wheel
To Left
Front Wheel
(b) Use tags or make a memo to identify the place to
reconnect.
To Left
Rear
Wheel
F051200E01
(c) Using SST, disconnect the 4 brake lines from the
hydraulic brake booster assembly.
SST 09023-00101
SST
F051171E01
(d) Remove the 4 nuts and pull out the hydraulic brake
booster assembly.
11. REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER GASKET
(a) Remove the brake booster gasket from the brake
master cylinder.
F051420
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–27
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE BRAKE ACTUATOR BRACKET NO. 1
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (5 mm), remove the bolt
and brake actuator bracket No. 1 from the brake
master cylinder.
F051421
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the brake fluid level
warning switch connector from the brake actuator
bracket No. 1.
F051180
2.
REMOVE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a pin punch and hammer, remove the pin
from the brake master cylinder reservoir subassembly.
Pin Punch
F051177E01
(b) Remove the screw and pull out the brake master
cylinder reservoir sub-assembly.
(c) Remove the master cylinder reservoir filler cap.
F051178E02
3.
F051181E03
REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
GROMMET
(a) Remove the 3 reservoir grommets from the master
cylinder reservoir sub-assembly.
BR
BR–28
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
4.
REMOVE BRAKE ACTUATOR HOSE
(a) Using needle nose pliers, slide the 2 clips and
remove the brake actuator hose and 2 clips.
5.
REMOVE BRAKE ACTUATOR TUBE NO. 1
(a) Using SST, remove the brake actuator tube No. 1
from the brake master cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
6.
REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER WITH ACCUMULATOR
PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 plugs.
F051182E02
SST
F051183E01
BR
F051185E01
(b) Remove the 2 screws and disconnect the wire
harnesses from the master cylinder solenoid.
F051186E02
(c) Using a screwdriver, remove the clip.
F051187
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–29
(d) Remove the brake booster with accumulator pump
assembly from the brake master cylinder.
(e) Remove the 2 brake booster pump collars and the 2
brake booster pump bushes from the brake booster
with accumulator pump assembly.
F051188
(f)
Using a hexagon wrench (4 mm), remove the 2
pins.
F051415E03
7.
REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER PUMP BRACKET NO. 2
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (5 mm), remove the 2
bolts and brake booster pump bracket No.2 from the
brake master cylinder solenoid.
(b) Remove the brake booster pump bush from the
brake booster pump bracket No. 2.
F051189E02
8.
REMOVE BRAKE ACTUATOR BRACKET NO. 3
(a) Remove the bolt and brake actuator bracket No. 3
from the brake master cylinder.
9.
REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER ACCUMULATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Secure the brake booster with accumulator pump
assembly in a vise.
(b) Remove the brake booster accumulator assembly.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the brake booster
accumulator assembly.
NOTICE:
Ensure no foreign matter enters the pump.
(d) Remove the brake booster accumulator pipe and
compression spring.
F051423
F052314
BR
BR–30
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
10. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and master cylinder solenoid.
F051195E02
(b) Remove the gasket.
F051196
11. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER PUSH ROD CLEVIS
(a) Loosen the lock nut on the rod operating adapter,
and remove the push rod clevis and lock nut.
BR
F051191E02
(b) Loosen the lock nut on the brake master cylinder
side, and remove the rod operating adapter and lock
nut.
12. REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER BOOT
F051192E02
C-ring
Pin
F051417E02
13. REMOVE PISTON
(a) Pressing the piston in with a screwdriver, use a pin
or equivalent to push the C-ring from the hole in the
master cylinder body then remove it with another
screwdriver.
(b) Remove the piston, pulling it straight out, not at an
angle.
NOTICE:
If pulled out at an angle, there is a possibility
that the cylinder bore could be damaged.
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–31
INSPECTION
1.
Red Cable
Black
Cable
INSPECT BRAKE BOOSTER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the
red cable of the pump motor, and the negative (-)
lead to the black cable.
(b) Check brake booster pump motor operation.
F051410E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL PISTON
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to a new
piston.
(b) Install the piston.
(c) Using 2 screwdrivers, install a new snap ring while
pressing on the piston.
2.
INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER BOOT
3.
INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER PUSH ROD CLEVIS
(a) Install the brake master cylinder side lock nut and
rod operating adapter on the brake master cylinder.
Torque: 26 N*m (260 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
F051194
F051192E02
(b) Install the lock nut and master cylinder push rod
clevis on the rod operating adapter.
Torque: 26 N*m (260 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
F051191E02
4.
F051196
INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
(a) Install a new gasket.
NOTICE:
Keep all surfaces of the master cylinder
solenoid, master cylinder and gasket, especially
contact surfaces, away from water and dust.
BR
BR–32
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
(b) Install the master cylinder solenoid with 6 new bolts.
Torque: 32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
F051195E02
5.
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER ACCUMULATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the brake booster accumulator pipe and
compression spring.
NOTICE:
Ensure that no foreign matter enters the pump.
(b) Install a new O-ring to the brake booster
accumulator assembly.
(c) Install the brake booster accumulator assembly.
Torque: 57 N*m (585 kgf*cm, 42 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL BRAKE ACTUATOR BRACKET NO. 3
(a) Install the brake actuator bracket No. 3 to the brake
master cylinder with the bolt.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER PUMP BRACKET NO. 2
(a) Install the brake booster pump bush to the brake
booster pump bracket No. 2.
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (5 mm), install the brake
booster pump bracket No. 2 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER WITH ACCUMULATOR
PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (4 mm), install the 2 pins
to the brake master cylinder.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the 2 brake booster pump collars and 2 brake
booster pump bushes to the brake booster with
accumulator pump assembly.
F052314
BR
F051423
F051189E02
F051415E03
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–33
(c) Install the brake booster with accumulator pump
assembly to the brake master cylinder.
F051188
(d) Install a new clip.
F051199
(e) Install the wire harnesses with the 2 screws.
Torque: 2.9 N*m (30 kgf*cm, 26 in.*lbf)
BR
Red Cable
Black Cable
F051186E03
(f)
Install 2 new plugs.
F051185E01
9.
SST
Fulcrum Length
F051184E03
INSTALL BRAKE ACTUATOR TUBE NO. 1
(a) Using SST, install the brake actuator tube No. 1 to
the brake master cylinder assembly.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
250 mm (9.84 in.).
HINT:
This torque value is effective when SST is parallel to
the torque wrench.
BR–34
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
10. INSTALL BRAKE ACTUATOR HOSE
(a) Using needle nose pliers, install the brake actuator
hose and 2 clips.
F051182E02
11. INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
GROMMET
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to 3 new
reservoir grommets.
(b) Install the 3 reservoir grommets to the brake master
cylinder.
HINT:
Be careful of the size of each grommet.
F051416
12. INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the brake master cylinder reservoir subassembly with the screw.
Torque: 1.7 N*m (17 kgf*cm, 15 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the master cylinder reservoir filler cap.
BR
F051178E02
(c) Using a pin punch and hammer, install a new pin to
the brake master cylinder reservoir sub-assembly.
Pin Punch
F051177E01
13. INSTALL BRAKE ACTUATOR BRACKET NO. 1
(a) Install the brake fluid level warning switch connector
to the brake actuator bracket No. 1.
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (5 mm), install the brake
actuator bracket No. 1 to the brake master cylinder
with the bolt.
Torque: 7.8 N*m (80 kgf*cm, 69 in.*lbf)
F051421E02
BRAKE – BRAKE SYSTEM
BR–1
BRAKE SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
• Care must be taken to replace each part properly as it
could affect the performance of the brake system and
result in a driving hazard. Replace the parts with parts
having the same part number or equivalent.
• It is very important to keep parts and the area clean
when repairing the brake system.
• It the vehicle is equipped with a mobile
communication system, refer to the precaution in the
INTRODUCTION section.
BR
BR–2
BRAKE – BRAKE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem.
The numbers indicate the likelihood of the cause of the
problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace
these parts.
BRAKE SYSTEM
Symptom
Low pedal or spongy pedal
Brake drag
BR
Brake pull
Hard pedal but brake inefficient
Suspected Area
See page
1. Fluid leaks for brake system
-
2. Air in brake system
BR-3
3. Piston seals (Worn or damaged) (Front)
BR-40
4. Piston seals (Worn or damaged) (Rear)
BR-46
5. Brake master cylinder (Faulty)
BR-17
1. Brake pedal free play (Minimum)
BR-8
2. Parking brake pedal travel (Out of adjustment)
PB-1
3. Parking brake wire (Sticking)
PB-8
4. Parking brake (Shoe clearance out of adjustment)
PB-15
5. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Front)
BR-40
6. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Rear)
BR-46
7. Piston (Stuck) (Front)
BR-40
8. Piston (Stuck) (Rear)
BR-46
9. Piston (Frozen) (Front)
BR-40
10.Piston (Frozen) (Rear)
BR-46
11.Tension or return spring (Faulty)
PB-15
12.Brake master cylinder (Faulty)
BR-17
1. Piston (Stuck) (Front)
BR-40
2. Piston (Stuck) (Rear)
BR-46
3. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Front)
BR-40
4. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Rear)
BR-46
5. Piston (Frozen) (Front)
BR-40
6. Piston (Frozen) (Rear)
BR-46
7. Disc (Scored) (Front)
BR-40
8. Disc (Scored) (Rear)
BR-46
9. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Front)
BR-40
10.Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Rear)
BR-46
11.Brake master cylinder (Faulty)
BR-17
1. Fluid leaks for brake system
-
2. Air in brake system
BR-3
3. Pad (Worn) (Front)
BR-40
4. Pad (Worn) (Rear)
BR-46
5. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Front)
BR-40
6. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Rear)
BR-46
7. Pad (Oily) (Front)
BR-40
8. Pad (Oily) (Rear)
BR-46
9. Pad (Glazed) (Front)
BR-40
10. Pad (Glazed) (Rear)
BR-46
11. Disc (Scored) (Front)
BR-40
12. Disc (Scored) (Rear)
BR-46
13. Brake master cylinder (Faulty)
BR-17
BR–3
BRAKE – BRAKE SYSTEM
Symptom
Noise from brakes
Brake warning light lights up*1 (Parking brake pedal
released)
Brake warning light lights up and skid control buzzer
sounds*2
ABS warning light lights up*3
Suspected Area
See page
1. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Front)
BR-40
2. Pad (Cracked or distorted) (Rear)
BR-46
3. Installation bolt (Loose)
BR-46
4. Disc (Scored) (Front)
BR-40
5. Disc (Scored) (Rear)
BR-46
6. Pad support plate (Loose)
BR-46
7. Sliding pin (Worn)
BR-46
8. Pad (Dirty) (Front)
BR-40
9. Pad (Dirty) (Rear)
BR-46
10.Pad (Glazed) (Front)
BR-40
11.Pad (Glazed) (Rear)
BR-46
12.Tension or return spring (Faulty)
PB-15
13.Anti-squeal shim (Damaged) (Front)
BR-40
14.Anti-squeal shim (Damaged) (Rear)
BR-46
15.Shoe hold-down spring (Damaged)
PB-15
1. Brake fluid level
BR-3
2. Brake master cylinder power supply system (Faulty)
BR-17
Brake master cylinder power supply system (Faulty)
BR-17
1. Anti-lock brake system (Faulty)
-
2. Brake master cylinder power supply system (Faulty)
BR-17
HINT:
• *1, *3: The light may stay on for about 60 seconds after the
engine starts. It is normal if it goes off after a while.
• *2, *3: Depressing the brake pedal repeatedly may turn on
the warning light and buzzer. It is normal if the light goes
off and the buzzer stops sounding after a few seconds.
• *3: While ABS warning light is ON, both VSC warning light
and VSC OFF indicator light come on.
BR
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–35
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER GASKET
(a) Install a new brake booster gasket on the master
cylinder.
2.
INSTALL HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hydraulic brake booster assembly with
the 4 nuts.
Torque: 14 N*m (145 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
F051420
To Right
Front Wheel
To Right
Rear Wheel
To Left
Front Wheel
(b) Connect the 4 brake lines to the correct positions of
the hydraulic brake booster assembly as shown in
the illustration.
To Left
Rear
Wheel
BR
F051200E01
(c) Using SST, torque the 4 brake lines.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 14 N*m (145 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
250 mm (9.84 in.).
HINT:
This torque value is effective when SST is parallel to
the torque wrench.
Fulcrum
length
F051172E01
BR–36
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
(d) Connect the 3 connectors to the hydraulic brake
booster assembly.
F051439E02
BR
3.
INSTALL PUSH ROD PIN
(a) Install the clip and push rod pin to the clevis.
4.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
(a) Install the steering column hole cover with the 4
clips.
5.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
6.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
7.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
8.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
9.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
F051429E01
10. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
11. FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
HINT:
(See page BR-3)
12. BLEED BRAKE BOOSTER WITH ACCUMULATOR
PUMP ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page BR-3)
13. BLEED BRAKE LINE
HINT:
(See page BR-3)
14. BLEED MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
HINT:
(See page BR-3)
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–37
15. CHECK BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT
HINT:
(See page BR-8)
16. CHECK PEDAL FREE PLAY
HINT:
(See page BR-8)
17. CHECK PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE
HINT:
(See page BR-8)
18. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
HINT:
(See page BR-17)
19. CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
20. INSPECT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER OPERATION
HINT:
(See page BR-17)
DISPOSAL
1.
A
B
F051409E01
DISPOSE OF BRAKE BOOSTER ACCUMULATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the brake booster accumulator assembly in a
vise and cover it with cloth.
(b) Using a saw, cut the brake booster accumulator
body between A and B as shown in the illustration to
discharge the gas inside.
CAUTION:
• Cover with a piece of cloth when working
because gas may blow out.
• Carefully, not abruptly, cut the assembly.
• Wear protective glasses.
(c) When the outer body of the brake booster
accumulator is cut, gas and liquid discharge.
HINT:
The gas is colorless, odorless and non-poisonous.
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–3
BRAKE FLUID
BLEEDING
NOTICE:
• Wash off brake fluid immediately if it comes into
contact with a painted surface.
• If the brake pedal is depressed with the reservoir cap
removed, then brake fluid will spatter.
HINT:
• If any work is done on the brake system or if air in the
brake lines is suspected, bleed the air from the system.
• When bleeding, keep the amount of the fluid between the
Min. and Max. lines on the reservoir.
1.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
Fluid:
SAE J1703 or FMVSS NO. 116 DOT3
2.
BLEED BRAKE BOOSTER W/ACCUMULATOR PUMP
ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Perform this step only if the brake booster with
accumulator pump assembly is removed and/or
installed.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off, depress the brake pedal
20 times or more, and release the pressure from the
accumulator.
(b) Fully depress the brake pedal 10 times.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and start
the brake booster pump.
(d) Make sure the pump operates for 8 to 14 seconds.
If the pump does not operate as specified, repeat
steps (a) to (c) and recheck the operating time.
3.
F052299
BLEED BRAKE LINE
(a) Front brake line
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and
wait until the pump motor has stopped.
(2) Connect the vinyl tube to the brake caliper.
(3) Depress the brake pedal several times, then
loosen the bleeder plug with the pedal held
down.
(4) At the point when the fluid stops coming out,
tighten the bleeder plug, then release the brake
pedal.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
(5) Repeat (3) and (4) until all the air in the fluid
has been bled out.
(6) Repeat the above procedures to bleed the
other brake line.
BR
BR–4
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(b) Rear brake line
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and
depress the brake pedal.
(2) Connect the vinyl tube to the brake caliper.
(3) Loosen the bleeder plug and release air.
HINT:
Brake fluid is sent through the pump, so keep
the brake pedal depressed until the air is
completely bled out.
(4) When the air is completely bled out of the brake
fluid through the bleeder plug, tighten the
bleeder plug.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
(5) Repeat the above procedures to bleed the
other brake line.
F052300
4.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Select "ACTIVE TEST" mode on the intelligent
tester.
(d) Connect the vinyl tube to the rear brake caliper.
(e) Loosen the bleeder plug.
(f) Select "SRMF & SRMR" to drive the solenoids and
bleed air from the rear brake caliper.
NOTICE:
Do not depress the brake pedal.
HINT:
• Brake fluid is sent through the pump.
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent tester
turns OFF automatically 2 seconds after every
solenoid has been turned ON.
(g) Repeat step (f) until all the air in the brake fluid is
bled out.
(h) When the air is completely bled out of the brake fluid
through the bleeder plug, tighten the bleeder plug.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
(i) Repeat the above procedures to bleed the other
brake line.
(j) Turn the ignition switch off.
(k) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(l) Clear DTC (See page BC-39).
Intelligent Tester
BR
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
HINT:
Perform this step only if the master cylinder solenoid is
removed and/or installed.
DLC3
F051426E01
5.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
HINT:
(See page BR-17)
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
BR–41
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check the cylinder bore and piston for rust or
scoring.
2.
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.5 mm (0.453 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3.
INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
F042679
BR
F042680
4.
F043106
INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily fasten the disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10
mm (0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
(c) If the disc runout is maximum value or greater,
check the bearing play in the axial direction and
check the axle hub runout (See page AH-1). If the
bearing play and axle hub runout are normal, adjust
the disc runout or grind it on a "On-car" brake lathe.
BR–42
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
(a) Aligning the matchmarks, install the front disc.
HINT:
When replacing the disc with a new one, select the
installation position where the disc has the minimum
runout.
2.
INSPECT DISC RUNOUT (See page BR-41)
3.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT DISC BRAKE
BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Temporarily tighten the bleeder plug to the disc
brake cylinder assembly.
(b) Install the breeder plug cap to the breeder plug.
4.
INSTALL PISTON SEAL
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to the 4
new piston seals.
(b) Install the 4 piston seals to the disc brake cylinder
assembly.
5.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE PISTON
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to the 4
disc brake pistons.
(b) Install the 4 disc brake pistons on the disc brake
cylinder assembly.
NOTICE:
Do not screw the disc brake piston forcedly in
the disc brake cylinder assembly.
6.
INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Apply the lithium soap grease glycol grease to the 4
new cylinder boots.
(b) Install the 4 cylinder boots on the disc brake cylinder
assembly.
HINT:
Install the cylinder boot securely on the grooves of
the disc brake cylinder and piston.
BR
INSTALLATION
1.
F043121
INSTALL DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the disc brake cylinder assembly with 2 bolts.
Torque: 123 N*m (1,254 kgf*cm, 91 ft.*lbf)
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
BR–43
(b) Using SST, connect the brake tube to the disc brake
cylinder assembly.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15.2 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL ANTI SQUEAL SHIM KIT FRONT
NOTICE:
If necessary, replace the anti-squeal shim kit when
replacing the brake pad.
(a) Install the anti-squeal shims on each brake pads.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease on the friction
surfaces of the brake pads and the front disc.
3.
INSTALL DISC BRAKE PAD KIT FRONT (PAD ONLY)
(a) Install the 2 disc brake pads with anti-squeal shim to
the disc brake cylinder assembly.
4.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE ANTIRATTLE W/HOLE
PIN
(a) Install the 2 anti-rattle w/ hole pins and anti-rattle
spring to the disc brake cylinder.
HINT:
Anti-rattle spring is installed with bottom side of antirattle w/ hole pin.
(b) Install the 2 new pin hole clips to the anti-rattle w/
hole pin.
NOTICE:
When installing the pin hole clip, be sure to
install the pin hole clip with the handle facing to
the vehicle center.
F043120
5.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
6.
BLEED BRAKE LINE
HINT:
(See page BR-3)
7.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
8.
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
9.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
BR
BR–5
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BRAKE PEDAL
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PLATE
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER
BR
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
VSC BUZZER CONNECTOR
SKID CONTROL ECU ASSEMBLY
SKID CONTROL ECU ASSEMBLY
SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C134071E01
BR–6
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
CUSHION
BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
CONNECTOR
14.2 (145, 10)
BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
34.3 (350, 25)
BRAKE PEDAL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
BRAKE PEDAL
SHAFT COLLAR
BR
COLLAR
BRAKE PEDAL
SHAFT COLLAR
BRAKE PEDAL LINK
CLIP
E-RING
BRAKE
PEDAL LINK
BRAKE PEDAL
LINK PIN
34.3 (350, 25)
BRAKE PEDAL PAD
COLLAR
BRAKE
BRAKE
PEDAL LEVER PEDAL BUSH
BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
34.3 (350, 25)
BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT
REINFORCEMENT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
C131294E01
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
BR–47
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check the cylinder bore and piston for rust or
scarring.
2.
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3.
INSPECT REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(a) Inspect the 4 pad support plates. Make sure the
plates have sufficient rebound check for
deformation, cracks or wear, rust, dirt or foreign
particles.
4.
INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
18.0 mm (0.709 in.)
Minimum thickness:
16.0 mm (0.630 in.)
F043130
BR
F043131
5.
F043187
INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily fasten the disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10
mm (0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
(c) If the disc runout is the maximum value or greater,
check the bearing play in the axial direction and
check the axle hub runout (See page AH-1). If the
bearing play and axle hub runout are normal, adjust
the disc runout or grind it on a "On-car" brake lathe.
BR–48
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
REASSEMBLY
BR
1.
INSTALL REAR DISC
(a) Align the matchmarks and install the rear disc.
2.
INSPECT DISC RUNOUT (See page BR-47)
3.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR DISC BRAKE
BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Temporarily tighten the bleeder plug to the disc
brake cylinder assembly rear.
(b) Install the bleeder plug cap on the bleeder plug.
4.
INSTALL PISTON SEAL
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to a new
piston seal.
(b) Install the piston seal on the disc brake cylinder
assembly rear.
5.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE PISTON
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to a disc
brake piston.
(b) Install the disc brake piston on the disc brake
cylinder assembly rear.
NOTICE:
Do not screw the disc brake piston forcedly in
the disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
6.
INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to a new
cylinder boot.
(b) Install the cylinder boot on the disc brake cylinder
HINT:
Install the cylinder boot securely on the grease of
the disc brake cylinder assembly and piston.
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–13
HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
INSTRUMENT
PANEL FINISH
PLATE
BR
CLIP
STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
COWL SIDE
TRIM BOARD LH
CLIP
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
C131297E02
BR–14
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
CLIP
PUSH ROD PIN
BRAKE BOOSTER
GASKET
HYDRAULIC BRAKE
BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
BR
14 (145, 10)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
16 (158, 11)
*14 (146, 11)
Non-reusable part
* For use with SST
C131298E01
BR–15
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BRAKE ACTUATOR BRACKET NO. 3
MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR FILLER CAP ASSEMBLY
1.7 (17, 15 in.*lbf)
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR SUB-ASSEMBLY
MASTER CYLINDER
PUSH ROD CLEVIS
PIN
MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR GROMMET
LOCK NUT
26 (260, 19)
7.8 (80, 69 in.*lbf)
PISTON
ROD OPERATING
ADAPTER
x6
BOLT
MASTER CYLINDER BOOT
32 (326, 24)
C-RING
BRAKE ACTUATOR
BRACKET NO. 1
GASKET
MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
7.8 (80, 69 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
C131299E01
BR
BR–16
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
57 (585, 42)
BRAKE BOOSTER ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
O-RING
COMPRESSION SPRING
BRAKE BOOSTER ACCUMULATOR PIPE
BRAKE BOOSTER PUMP ASSEMBLY
BRAKE BOOSTER PUMP COLLAR
BRAKE BOOSTER PUMP BUSH
BRAKE BOOSTER
PUMP BRACKET NO. 2
BR
15 (155, 11)
*14(143, 10)
BRAKE ACTUATOR
TUBE NO. 1
PLUG
7.8 (80, 69 in.*lbf)
2.9 (30, 26 in.*lbf)
PIN
BRAKE BOOSTER
PUMP BUSH
CLIP
BRAKE BOOSTER
PUMP BUSH
7.8 (80, 69 in.*lbf)
BRAKE ACTUATOR HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
* For use with SST
C131300E02
BR–17
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Brake Pedal
Effort Gauge
SST
1.
SST
INSPECT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER FLUID
PRESSURE CHANGE
(a) Inspect the battery voltage.
Battery voltage:
11 to 14 V
(b) Turn the ignition switch off and depress the brake
pedal more than 40 times.
HINT:
When pressure in the power supply system is
released, reaction force becomes light and stroke
becomes longer.
(c) Install the LSPV gauge (SST) and brake pedal effort
gauge, and bleed air.
SST 09709-29018
(d) When the booster does not operate:
Depress the brake pedal and check fluid pressure.
At 245 N (25 kgf, 55 lbf):
Front brake pressure
Rear brake pressure
2
F043137E02
3,150 kPa (32.1 kgf/cm , 457 psi) or
more
0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
At 343 N (35 kgf, 77 lbf):
Front brake pressure
2
4,540 kPa (46.3 kgf/cm , 659 psi) or
more
Rear brake pressure
0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
(e) When the booster operates:
Depress the brake pedal and check fluid pressure.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and
wait until the pump motor has stopped.
(2) Depress the brake pedal and check fluid
pressure.
At 49 N (5 kgf, 11 lbf):
Front brake pressure
Rear brake pressure
1,120 to 2,320 kPa
1,220 to 2,420 kPa
(11.4 to 23.7 kgf/cm2, 162 to 337 psi)
(12.4 to 24.7 kgf/cm2, 177 to 351 psi)
At 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf):
Front brake pressure
Rear brake pressure
3,840 to 5,040 kPa
3,990 to 5,190 kPa
(39.2 to 51.4 kgf/cm2, 557 to 731 psi)
(40.7 to 52.9 kgf/cm2, 579 to 753 psi)
At 147 N (15 kgf, 33 lbf):
Front brake pressure
Rear brake pressure
6,460 to 7,660 kPa
6,660 to 7,860 kPa
(65.9 to 78.1 kgf/cm2, 937 to 1,111 psi)
(67.9 to 80.1 kgf/cm2, 966 to 1,140 psi)
At 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbf):
Front brake pressure
Rear brake pressure
8,720 to 9,920 kPa
11,330 to 12,530 kPa
(88.9 to 101.2 kgf/cm2, 1,265 to 1,439
psi)
(115.5 to 127.8 kgf/cm2, 1,644 to 1,818
psi)
BR
BR–18
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
2.
Intelligent Tester
BR
DLC3
F051426E01
INSPECT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER OPERATION
(a) Inspect the battery voltage.
Battery voltage:
11 to 14 V
(b) Turn the ignition switch off and depress the brake
pedal more than 20 times.
HINT:
When pressure in the power supply system is
released, reaction force decreases and stroke
becomes longer.
(c) Check that the brake pedal reaction force
decreases.
If the pedal reaction force does not decreases,
check and replace the brake line and brake master
cylinder.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and
check the pump motor operation noise.
If the pump motor does not operate, check and
replace the wire harness and pump motor (See
page BR-25).
(e) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Select "ACTIVE TEST" mode on the intelligent
tester.
HINT:
Please refer to the intelligent tester operator's
manual for further details.
(h) Jack up and support the vehicle.
(i) Release the parking brake lever.
(j) Shift the transfer shift lever to the "N" position and
check that the rear wheels rotate by hand.
(k) Inspect front VSC solenoid (SMCF) operation.
(1) Select "SRCF (SMCF)" on the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SRCF (SMCF)" ON with the
intelligent tester, depress the brake pedal with
stable force and check that the pedal cannot be
depressed.
If the pedal can be depressed, replace the
brake master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
To protect the solenoids, the intelligent tester
turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after every
solenoid has been turned ON.
(3) Release the brake pedal.
(4) When the solenoid is OFF, depress the brake
pedal again and check that the brake pedal can
be depressed.
If the pedal cannot be depressed, replace the
brake master cylinder.
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–19
(l)
Inspect front VSC solenoid (SREA) operation.
(1) Select "SRCR (SREA)" and "SRCF (SMCF)"
on the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SRCR (SREA)" and "SRCF (SMCF)"
ON simultaneously with the intelligent tester,
then depress the brake pedal with stable force.
(3) When the solenoids are ON, check that the
front wheels do not rotate by hand.
If the front wheels rotate, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheels fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheels as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoids are OFF, turn the "SRCF
(SMCF)" ON again, and then depress the brake
pedal. Then check the front wheels by rotating
them by hand.
If the front wheels stop, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(5) When the "SRCF (SMCF)" is OFF, depress the
brake pedal again and check that the brake
pedal can be depressed.
If the pedal cannot be depressed, replace the
brake master cylinder.
(m) Inspect front ABS solenoid (SFRH) operation.
(1) Select "SFRH" on the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SFRH" ON with the intelligent tester,
then depress the brake pedal with stable force.
(3) When the solenoid is ON, check the right front
wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the right front wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheel as
slowly as possible.
BR
BR–20
BR
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
(4) When the solenoid is OFF, depress the brake
pedal again and check that the right front wheel
does not rotate by hand.
If the right front wheel rotates, replace the
brake master cylinder.
HINT:
When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot be
made properly. Rotate the wheel as slowly as
possible.
(n) Inspect front ABS solenoid (SFLH) operation.
(1) Select "SFLH" on the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SFLH" ON with the intelligent tester,
then depress the brake pedal with stable force.
(3) When the solenoid is ON, check the left front
wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the left front wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheel as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoid is OFF, depress the brake
pedal again and check that the left front wheel
does not rotate by hand.
If the left front wheel rotates, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(o) Inspect front ABS solenoid (SFRR) operation.
(1) Select "SFRR" and "SFRH" on the intelligent
tester.
(2) Depress the brake pedal with stable force, then
turn the "SFRR" and "SFRH" ON
simultaneously with the intelligent tester.
(3) When the solenoids are ON, check that the
right front wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the right front wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–21
• When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheel as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoids are OFF, depress the
brake pedal again and check that the right front
wheel does not rotate by hand.
If the right front wheel rotates, replace the
brake master cylinder.
(p) Inspect front ABS solenoid (SFLR) operation.
(1) Select "SFLR" and "SFLH" on the intelligent
tester.
(2) Depress the brake pedal with stable force, then
turn the "SFLR" and "SFLH" ON
simultaneously with the intelligent tester.
(3) When the solenoids are ON, check the left front
wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the left front wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheel as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoids are OFF, depress the
brake pedal again and check that the left front
wheel does not rotate by hand.
If the left front wheel rotates, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(q) Inspect rear VSC solenoid (SREC) operation.
(1) Select "SRMF (SREC)" on the intelligent tester.
(2) Depress the brake pedal with stable force, then
turn the "SRMF (SREC)" ON with the intelligent
tester.
(3) Release the brake pedal when the solenoid is
on, and check that the rear wheels do not
rotate by hand.
If the rear wheels rotate, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
BR
BR–22
BR
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
• When rotating the wheels fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheels as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoid is OFF, check the rear
wheels by rotating them by hand.
If the rear wheels stop, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(r) Inspect rear VSC solenoid (STR) operation.
(1) Select "SRMR (STR)" and "SRMF (SREC)" on
the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SRMR (STR)" and "SRMF (SREC)"
ON simultaneously with the intelligent tester.
(3) When the solenoids are ON, check that the rear
wheels do not rotate by hand.
If the rear wheels rotate, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheels fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheels as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoids are OFF, turn the "SRMF
(SREC)" ON again, and check the rear wheels
by rotating them by hand.
If the rear wheels stop, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(5) When the "SRMF (SREC)" is OFF, depress the
brake pedal again and check that the rear
wheels do not rotate by hand.
If the rear wheels rotate, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(s) Inspect rear ABS solenoid (SRRH) operation.
(1) Select "SRRH" on the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SRRH" ON with the intelligent tester,
then depress the brake pedal with stable force.
(3) When the solenoid is ON, check the right rear
wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the right rear wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
BR–23
• When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheel as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoid is OFF, depress the brake
pedal again and check that the right rear wheel
does not rotate by hand.
If the right rear wheel rotates, replace the brake
master cylinder.
HINT:
When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot be
made properly. Rotate the wheel as slowly as
possible.
(t) Inspect rear ABS solenoid (SRLH) operation.
(1) Select "SRLH" on the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the "SRLH" ON with the intelligent tester,
then depress the brake pedal with stable force.
(3) When the solenoid is ON, check the left rear
wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the left rear wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheel fast, the fail-safe
function is activated and judgement cannot
be made properly. Rotate the wheel as
slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoid is OFF, depress the brake
pedal again and check that the left rear wheel
does not rotate by hand.
If the left rear wheel rotates, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(u) Inspect rear ABS solenoid (SRRR) operation.
(1) Select "SRRR" and "SRRH" on the intelligent
tester.
(2) Depress the brake pedal with stable force, then
turn the "SRRR" and "SRRH" ON
simultaneously with the intelligent tester.
(3) When the solenoids are ON, check the right
rear wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the right rear wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
BR
BR–24
BRAKE – HYDRAULIC BRAKE BOOSTER
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheel too fast, the failsafe function is activated and judgement
cannot be made properly. Rotate the wheel
as slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoids are OFF, depress the
brake pedal again and check that the right rear
wheel does not rotate by hand.
If the right rear wheel rotates, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(v) Inspect rear ABS solenoid (SRLR) operation.
(1) Select "SRLR"and "SRLH" on the intelligent
tester.
(2) Depress the brake pedal with stable force, then
turn the "SRLR" and "SRLH" ON
simultaneously with the intelligent tester.
(3) When the solenoids are ON, check the left rear
wheel by rotating it by hand.
If the left rear wheel stops, replace the brake
master cylinder.
NOTICE:
When operating it continuously, set the
interval of more than 20 seconds.
HINT:
• To protect the solenoids, the intelligent
tester turns OFF automatically 2 sec. after
every solenoid has been turned ON.
• When rotating the wheel too fast, the failsafe function is activated and judgement
cannot be made properly. Rotate the wheel
as slowly as possible.
(4) When the solenoids are OFF, depress the
brake pedal again and check that the left rear
wheel does not rotate by hand.
If the left rear wheel rotates, replace the brake
master cylinder.
(w) Lower the vehicle.
(x) Disconnect the intelligent tester.
BR
3.
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
(a) Turn the ignition switch off, depress the brake pedal
20 times or more (until the pedal reaction feels light
and pedal stroke becomes longer), and adjust the
fluid level to the MAX level.
(b) When the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position, brake fluid is sent to the accumulator and
the fluid level decreases by approximately 5 mm
from the level when the ignition switch is off
(normal).
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
BR–49
INSTALLATION
F043126
F043124
1.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE
BUSH
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to a new
cylinder hole plug and 2 new cylinder slide bushes.
(b) Install the cylinder hole plug and 2 cylinder slide
bush to the rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
2.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING
LH
(a) Install the rear disc brake cylinder mounting with 2
bolts.
Torque: 105 N*m (1,071 kgf*cm, 77 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(a) Install the 4 pad support plates on the rear disc
brake cylinder mounting.
4.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE PAD WEAR INDICATOR
PLATE
(a) Install the pad wear indicator plate on the inner side
disc brake pad.
HINT:
Install the pad wear indicator facing downward.
5.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE ANTI-SQUEL SHIM
NOTICE:
If necessary, replace the anti-squeal shim kit when
replacing the brake pad.
(a) Install the anti-squeal shims on each brake pad.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease on the friction
surfaces of the brake pads and the rear disc.
6.
INSTALL DISC BRAKE PAD KIT REAR (PAD ONLY)
(a) Install the 2 disc brake pads with anti-squeal shim to
the disc brake cylinder assembly.
7.
INSTALL DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Apply the lithium soap base glycol grease to the
sliding part of 2 cylinder slide pins.
(b) Install the disc brake cylinder assembly rear with 2
cylinder slide pins.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
BR
BR–50
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
8.
CONNECT REAR LH FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Connect the flexible hose with union bolt and new
gasket to the disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
Torque: 31 N*m (316 kgf*cm, 23 ft.*lbf)
9.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
10. BLEED BRAKE LINE
HINT:
(See page BR-3)
F043125
11. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
12. CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
13. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
BR
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Brake
Section: Brake (front)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000001Q8Y007X
Title: BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 cylinder boots from
the caliper.
2. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE PISTON
(a) Prepare the wooden plate to hold the pistons.
(b) Place the plate between the pistons and insert a pad at
one side.
(c) Use compressed air to remove the pistons alternately from the cylinder.
CAUTION:
Do not place your fingers in front of the piston when using compressed air.
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
3. REMOVE PISTON SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 piston seals from the
cylinder.
4. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Remove the breeder plug cap and breeder plug from the disc brake cylinder assembly.
5. INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
6. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
7. INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
8. REMOVE FRONT DISC
(a) Make matchmarks on the disc and the axle hub.
(b) Remove the front disc.
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Brake
Section: Brake (front)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000001Q8V007X
Title: BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check the cylinder bore and piston for rust or scoring.
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.5 mm (0.453 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
4. INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily fasten the disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 110 N·m (1,122 kgf·cm, 81 ft·lbf)
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the
disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
(c) If the disc runout is maximum value or greater, check the bearing play in the axial direction and
check the axle hub runout
. If the bearing play and axle hub runout are normal, adjust the
disc runout or grind it on a "On-car" brake lathe.
AXLE: AXLE SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Drivetrain
Section: Axle/Differential
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000016ZS006X
Title: AXLE: AXLE SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the front wheel.
(b) Remove front disc brake caliper
.
(c) Remove the front disc.
(d) Inspect the axle hub backlash.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash near the center of the axle hub.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the bearing.
(e) Inspect the axle hub deviation.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the distortion at the
surface of the axle hub.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the deviation exceeds the maximum, replace the
bearing.
2. INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSEMBLY
AXLE: AXLE SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the rear wheel.
(b) Remove the rear disc brake caliper
.
(c) Remove the rear disc.
(d) Inspect the axle shaft backlash.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash near the center of the axle shaft.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the bearing.
(e) Inspect the axle shaft deviation.
(1) Using a dial indicator, check the distortion at the
surface of the axle shaft.
Maximum:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the deviation exceeds the maximum, replace the
bearing.
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Brake
Section: Brake (front)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000001Q8X007X
Title: BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
HINT:
Overhaul procedure of the RH side is the same as that of with LH side.
1. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2. DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash off the brake fluid immediately if it comes into contact with a painted surface.
3. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE ANTIRATTLE W/HOLE PIN
(a) Remove the 2 pin hole clips, then remove the 2 antirattle w/ hole pins from disc brake cylinder assembly.
(b) Remove the anti-rattle spring from the disc brake pad.
4. REMOVE DISC BRAKE PAD KIT FRONT (PAD ONLY)
(a) Remove the 2 disc brake pads with anti-squeal shim from the disc brake cylinder assembly.
5. REMOVE ANTI SQUEAL SHIM KIT FRONT
(a) Remove the 2 anti-squeal shims from each of the disc brake pads.
6. REMOVE DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using SST, disconnect the brake tube from the disc
brake cylinder assembly.
SST: 09023-00101
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
HINT:
Use a container to each brake fluid as it drains out.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and remove the disc brake cylinder
assembly.
BRAKE: REAR BRAKE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Brake
Section: Brake (rear)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000001Q93006X
Title: BRAKE: REAR BRAKE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
HINT:
Overhaul the RH side by using the same procedures as those for the LH side.
1. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2. DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash the brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surfaces.
3. DISCONNECT REAR LH FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and gasket from the disc brake
cylinder, then disconnect the flexible hose from the disc
brake cylinder assembly rear.
HINT:
Use a container to catch brake fluid as it drains out.
4. REMOVE DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Remove the 2 cylinder slide pins from disc brake
cylinder assembly rear.
(b) Remove the disc brake cylinder assembly rear from rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
5. REMOVE DISC BRAKE PAD KIT REAR (PAD ONLY)
BRAKE: REAR BRAKE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the 2 brake pads with anti-squeal shims from rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
6. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE ANTI-SQUEL SHIM
(a) Remove the 2 anti-squeal shims from each disc brake pads.
7. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PAD WEAR INDICATOR PLATE
(a) Remove the pad wear indicator plate from the inner side disc brake pad.
8. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(a) Remove the 4 pad support plates from the rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
9. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and rear brake cylinder mounting.
10. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE BUSH
(a) Remove the 2 cylinder slide bushes from the rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
(b) Remove the cylinder hole plug from the rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Brake
Section: Brake (front)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000001Q8V007X
Title: BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check the cylinder bore and piston for rust or scoring.
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.5 mm (0.453 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
4. INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily fasten the disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 110 N·m (1,122 kgf·cm, 81 ft·lbf)
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the
disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
(c) If the disc runout is maximum value or greater, check the bearing play in the axial direction and
check the axle hub runout
. If the bearing play and axle hub runout are normal, adjust the
disc runout or grind it on a "On-car" brake lathe.
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Brake
Section: Brake (front)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000001Q8V007X
Title: BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check the cylinder bore and piston for rust or scoring.
2. INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.5 mm (0.453 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3. INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness:
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
4. INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily fasten the disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 110 N·m (1,122 kgf·cm, 81 ft·lbf)
BRAKE: FRONT BRAKE: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the
disc.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
(c) If the disc runout is maximum value or greater, check the bearing play in the axial direction and
check the axle hub runout
. If the bearing play and axle hub runout are normal, adjust the
disc runout or grind it on a "On-car" brake lathe.
BR–44
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
REAR BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
88 (897 65)
11 (112, 8)
CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
BLEEDER PLUG
88 (897 65)
BLEEDER PLUG CAP
CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
PISTON SEAL
REAR FLEXIBLE HOSE
PAD SUPPORT PLATE
DISC BRAKE
PISTON
31 (316, 23)
UNION BOLT
GASKET
DISC BRAKE CYLINDER
ASSEMBLY REAR LH
BRAKE PAD
CYLINDER BOOT
ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM
105 (1,071, 77)
BR
ANTI-SQUEL
SHIM
PAD WEAR
INDICATOR
PLATE
REAR DISC BRAKE
CYLINDER MOUNTING LH
CYLINDER SLIDE BUSH
PAD SUPPORT PLATE
CYLINDER SLIDE BUSH
105 (1,071, 77)
CYLINDER HOLE PLUG
REAR DISC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
C131296E01
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
BR–45
REMOVAL
HINT:
Overhaul the RH side by using the same procedures as those
for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash the brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to
any painted surfaces.
3.
DISCONNECT REAR LH FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and gasket from the disc
brake cylinder, then disconnect the flexible hose
from the disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
HINT:
Use a container to catch brake fluid as it drains out.
4.
REMOVE DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY REAR
LH
(a) Remove the 2 cylinder slide pins from disc brake
cylinder assembly rear.
(b) Remove the disc brake cylinder assembly rear from
rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
F043125
5.
REMOVE DISC BRAKE PAD KIT REAR (PAD ONLY)
(a) Remove the 2 brake pads with anti-squeal shims
from rear disc brake cylinder mounting.
6.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE ANTI-SQUEL SHIM
(a) Remove the 2 anti-squeal shims from each disc
brake pads.
7.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PAD WEAR
INDICATOR PLATE
(a) Remove the pad wear indicator plate from the inner
side disc brake pad.
8.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(a) Remove the 4 pad support plates from the rear disc
brake cylinder mounting.
9.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING
LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and rear brake cylinder
mounting.
F043124
F043126
10. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE
BUSH
(a) Remove the 2 cylinder slide bushes from the rear
disc brake cylinder mounting.
(b) Remove the cylinder hole plug from the rear disc
brake cylinder mounting.
BR
BR–46
BRAKE – REAR BRAKE
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the cylinder boot from
disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
2.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PISTON
(a) Place a of cloth or equivalent between the piston
and the disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the piston from the
disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
CAUTION:
Do not place your fingers in front of the piston
when using compressed air.
NOTICE:
Do not spatter the brake fluid.
3.
REMOVE PISTON SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from
the disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
4.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Remove the bleeder plug cap and bleeder plug from
disc brake cylinder assembly rear.
5.
INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON (See page
BR-46)
6.
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS (See page BR-47)
7.
INSPECT REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(See page BR-47)
8.
INSPECT DISC THICKNESS (See page BR-47)
9.
REMOVE REAR DISC
(a) Make matchmarks on the rear disc and the axle
hub.
(b) Remove the rear disc.
F043127
F043128
BR
F043129
PB–4
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page IP-6)
2.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR
ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page AC-111)
3.
REMOVE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY CENTER
HINT:
(See page RS-428)
4.
REMOVE YAWRATE SENSOR
HINT:
(See page BC-215)
5.
REMOVE FLOOR SHIFT ASSEMBLY
Type
See procedure
A750F
AT-337
A750E
AT-327
6.
PB
D028115
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Release the parking brake pedal.
(b) Disconnect the parking brake switch connector.
(c) Remove the 3 nuts and parking brake control pedal
assembly.
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
7.
PB–5
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO.
1
(a) Remove the lock nut, adjusting nut, clip and
disconnect the parking brake cable assembly No. 1
from the parking brake control pedal assembly.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and 3 bolts from the parking
brake cable assembly No. 1.
D028116
PB
D028118
(c) Remove the lock nut, adjusting nut and parking
brake cable assembly No. 1 from the parking brake
equalize.
D028113
INSTALLATION
1.
D028113
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 1
(a) Install the parking brake cable assembly No. 1,
temporary tighten the adjusting nut and lock nut.
PB–6
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
(b) Install the parking brake cable assembly No. 1 with
the 2 nuts and 3 bolts.
(A)
(B)
(B)
(B)
(A)
D028118E01
Torque: NUT (A)
6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
BOLT (B)
13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
PB
(c) Install the parking brake cable assembly No. 1 with
the clip, adjusting nut and lock nut.
Torque: 13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(d) Bend the claw.
D028116
PB–7
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
2.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the parking brake control pedal assembly with
the 3 nuts.
Torque: 13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the parking brake switch connector.
3.
INSTALL FLOOR SHIFT ASSEMBLY
Type
See procedure
A750F
AT-341
A750E
AT-331
4.
INSTALL AIR BAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY CENTER
HINT:
(See page RS-428)
5.
INSTALL YAWRATE SENSOR
HINT:
(See page BC-216)
6.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page AC-121)
7.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page IP-12)
8.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
9.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
D028115
10. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
HINT:
(See page BC-23)
PB
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
PB–15
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BRAKE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
(a) Using a brake drum gauge or equivalent, measure
the inside diameter of the disk.
Standard inside diameter:
210mm (8.27 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
211mm (8.30 in.)
2.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE LINING
THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the thickness of the shoe
lining.
Standard inside diameter:
4.0mm (0.158 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
1.0mm (0.039 in.)
If the lining thickness is at the minimum thickness or
less, or if there is severe or uneven wear, replace
the brake shoe.
3.
INSPECT BRAKE DISC AND PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LINING FOR PROPER CONTACT
(a) Apply chalk to the inside surface of the disc, then
grind down the brake shoe lining to fit.
If the contact between the brake disc and the shoe
lining is improper, repair it using a brake shoe
grinder or replace the brake shoe assembly.
F006409
BR05332
BR00828
REASSEMBLY
1.
BR05332
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE LINING
THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the thickness of the shoe
lining.
Standard thickness:
4.0 mm (0.158 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0mm (0.039 in.)
If the lining thickness is at the minimum thickness or
less, or if there is severe or uneven wear, replace
the brake shoe.
PB
PB–16
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
2.
INSPECT BRAKE DISC AND PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LINING FOR PROPER CONTACT
(a) Apply chalk to the inside surface of the disc, then
grind down the brake shoe lining to fit.
If the contact between the brake disc and the shoe
lining is improper, repair it using a brake shoe
grinder or replace the brake shoe assembly.
3.
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE
(a) Apply the high temperature grease to the shoe
attached surface of backing plate (See page PB13).
4.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE
(a) Install the shoe lever and the shim to the rear shoe
with a new C-washer.
BR00828
(b) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
Less than 0.25 mm (0.0098 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specification,
replace the shim with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in. )
0.4 mm (0.016 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
-
R000343
(c) Apply the high temperature grease to the adjusting
bolt and piece.
(d) Install the shoe adjusting screw set and the tension
spring to the front and rear shoe.
(e) Install the 2 pins, 4 cups and 2 shoe hold-down
springs.
(f) Connect the parking brake cable to the shoe lever.
(g) Install the front and rear parking brake shoe.
PB
5.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
6.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING
7.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING
(a) Using a needle nose pliers, install the 2 return
tension springs.
HINT:
Install front side spring first, rear side spring next.
8.
CHECK PARKING BRAKE INSTALLATION
(a) Check that each part is installed properly.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surface of the shoe lining and disk.
F041705
PB–17
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
RH
LH
Front
Front
D028130E02
9.
Expand
Contract
D028131E02
INSTALL REAR DISC
10. ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
(a) Temporarily install the hub nuts.
(b) Remove the hole plug, and turn the adjuster and
expand the shoes until the disc locks.
(c) Contract the shoe adjuster until the disc rotates
smoothly.
Standard :
Return 8 notches
(d) Check the shoe has no brake drag.
(e) Install the hoke plug.
11. INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the rear disc brake caliper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 105 N*m (1,071 kgf*cm, 77 ft.*lbf)
12. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
13. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
14. ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
PB
PB–1
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to find the cause of the problem. The
numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause of the
problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace
these parts.
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
Symptom
Brake drag
Suspected Area
See page
1. Parking brake pedal travel (Out of adjustment)
PB-1
2. Parking brake wire (Sticking)
PB-8
3. Parking brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
PB-15
4. Parking brake shoe lining (Cracked or distorted)
PB-15
5. Tension or return spring (Damaged)
PB-15
PB
PB–2
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
ADJUSTMENT
D028113
PB
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
HINT:
(See page PB-15)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
(a) Slowly depress the parking brake pedal all the way,
and count the number of clicks.
Parking brake pedal travel at 294 N (30 kgf, 66
lbf):
5 to 7 clicks
5.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
(a) Remove the console rear panel upper.
(b) Remove the console panel upper.
(c) Remove the rear console box.
(d) Confirm that the parking brake pedal is released.
(e) Loosen the lock nut and turn the adjusting nut until
the parking brake pedal travel is corrected to the
specification.
(f) Tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(g) Check whether parking brake drags or not.
(h) When operating the parking brake pedal, check that
the parking brake pedal indicator light comes on.
(i) Install the rear console box.
(j) Install the console panel upper.
(k) Install the console rear panel upper.
PB–2
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
PARKING BRAKE
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
13 (127, 9)
13 (127, 9)
ADJUSTING NUT
PB
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
LOCK NUT
13 (127, 9)
PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY NO. 1
PARKING PEDAL PAD
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
PEDAL ASSEMBLY
CLIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131301E01
PB–3
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
13 (127, 9)
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSEMBLY
ADJUSTING NUT
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
13 (127, 9)
LOCK NUT
CONSOLE BOX
DUCT NO. 1
PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY NO. 1
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
PB
13 (127, 9)
13 (127, 9)
PARKING BRAKE
EQUALIZER
12 (122, 9)
ADJUSTING
NUT
13 (156, 10)
13 (127, 9)
LOCK NUT
FLOOR SHIFT ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
YAWRATE SENSOR
C131302E02
PB–8
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
13 (127, 9)
13 (127, 9)
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 2
13 (127, 9)
PB
CLIP
13 (127, 9)
13 (127, 9)
PARKING BRAKE EQUALIZER
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 3
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131303E03
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PB–9
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc
brake caliper assembly LH.
HINT:
Don not disconnect the flexible hose from the brake
caliper assembly LH.
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC (See page PB-14)
4.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN
TENSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
5.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING (See page PB-14)
6.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
7.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-14)
8.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
9.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
10. REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
(See page IP-7)
11. REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
12. REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR (See
page IP-9)
13. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO.
3
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the parking
brake cable assembly No. 3 from the backing plate.
D028121
PB
PB–10
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
(b) Remove the 4 bolts from the parking cable
assembly No. 3.
D028122
(c) Remove the clip and disconnect the parking brake
cable assembly No. 3 from the parking brake
equalizer.
PB
D028123
INSTALLATION
1.
D028123
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY NO. 3
(a) Install the parking brake cable assembly no. 3 with
the clip to the parking brake equalizer.
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PB–11
(b) Install the parking brake cable assembly No. 3 with
the 4 bolts.
D028122
Torque: 13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the parking brake cable assembly No. 3 with
the 2 bolts to the backing plate.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
D028121
2.
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE (See page
PB-16)
3.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE (See page PB-16)
4.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
5.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING
6.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING (See page PB-16)
7.
CHECK PARKING BRAKE INSTALLATION (See page
PB-16)
8.
INSTALL REAR DISC
9.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (See
page PB-17)
10. INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the rear disc brake caliper assembly LH with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 105 N*m (1,071 kgf*cm, 77 ft.*lbf)
11. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 112 N*m (1,137 kgf*cm, 83 ft.*lbf)
12. INSTALL CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
PB
PB–12
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
13. INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
14. INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
15. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
16. ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
HINT:
(See page PB-1)
PB
PB–13
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
SHOE HOLD -DOWN SPRING PIN
REAR DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY LH
105 (1,071, 83)
PARKING BRAKE SHOE
RETURN TENSION SPRING
SHIM
SHOE HOLD-DOWN
SPRING
C-WASHER
PB
PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT COMPRESSION SPRING
PARKING BRAKE
SHOE LEVER
PARKING
BRAKE
SHOE
PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN
TENSION SPRING
ADJUSTING
PIECE
ADJUSTING
BOLT
SHOE ADJUSTING
SCREW SET
PARKING BRAKE SHOE
HOLE PLUG
PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
SHOE HOLD-DOWN SPRING CUP
REAR DISC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Compressor oil ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
C131304E01
PB–14
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE ASSEMBLY
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc
brake caliper assembly LH.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the brake
caliper.
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC
(a) Release the parking brake, and remove rear disc.
HINT:
• Put matchmarks on the disc and remove the axle
shaft.
• If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the
shoe adjuster until the wheel turns freely.
4.
INSPECT BRAKE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
(a) Using a brake drum gauge or equivalent, measure
the inside diameter of the disc.
Standard inside diameter:
210mm (8.27 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
211mm (8.30 in.)
5.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN
TENSION SPRING
(a) Using a needle-nose pliers, remove the 2 return
tension springs.
6.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT
COMPRESSION SPRING
(a) Slide out the front shoe and remove the
compression spring.
7.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
8.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE
(a) Release the cup claw and remove the front and rear
parking brake shoe.
(b) Disconnect the parking brake cable from the shoe
lever.
(c) Remove the tension spring and shoe adjuster screw
set from the front rear shoe.
(d) Remove the 2 shoe hold-down springs, 4 cups and
2 pins.
(e) Using a screwdriver, remove the C-washer.
(f) Remove the shim and shoe lever from the parking
brake shoe.
Contract
D028126E06
PB
F006409
D028127
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
SR–3
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Maximum
Free Play
30 mm (1.18 in.)
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL FREE PLAY
(a) Stop the vehicle and align the tires facing straight
ahead.
(b) Gently turn the steering wheel right and left by hand,
and check the steering wheel free play.
Maximum free play:
30 mm (1.18 in.)
HINT:
If the free play exceeds the maximum, check the
steering column, steering intermediate shaft,
steering sliding yoke, or steering gear.
C115520E01
SR
SR–4
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
ADJUSTMENT
1.
STEERING OFF CENTER ADJUSTMENT
PROCEDURE
HINT:
This is the adjustment procedure for steering off center.
(a) Inspect steering wheel off center.
(1) Apply masking tape on the top center of the
steering wheel and steering column upper
cover.
(2) Drive the vehicle in a straight line for 100
meters at a constant speed of 35 mph (56 km/
h), and hold the steering wheel to maintain the
course.
Steering Wheel
Masking Tape
Steering Column
Upper Cover
F016015E08
(3) Draw a line on the masking tape as shown in
the illustration.
(4) Turn the steering wheel to the center position.
HINT:
Look at the upper surface of the steering
wheel, steering spoke and SRS airbag line to
find the center position.
Steering Column
Upper Cover
Marked Line
SR
Steering Wheel
Masking
Tape
F016016E10
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
SR–5
(5) Draw a new line on the masking tape on the
steering wheel as shown in the illustration.
(6) Measure the distance between the 2 lines on
the masking tape on the steering wheel.
(7) Convert the measured distance to steering
angle.
HINT:
• Measured distance 1 mm (0.04 in.) =
Steering angle of approximately 1 degree.
• Make a note of the steering angle.
Steering Column
Upper Cover
Marked Line
Steering Wheel
F016017E07
Marked Line
R000429E09
F016018E04
(b) Adjust steering angle.
(1) Draw a line on the RH and LH tie rod ends and
rack ends respectively where it can be easily
seen.
(2) Using a paper gauge, measure the distance
from the RH and LH tie rod ends to the rack
end screws.
HINT:
• Measure both the RH and LH sides.
• Make a note of the measured values.
(3) Remove the RH and LH boot clips from the
rack boots.
(4) Loosen the RH and LH lock nuts.
(5) Turn the RH and LH rack ends by the same
amount (but in different directions) according to
the steering angle.
HINT:
One 360 degree turn of rack end (1.5 mm
(0.059 in.) horizontal movement) equals to 12
degrees of steering angle.
(6) Tighten the RH and LH lock nuts to the
specified torque.
Torque: 56 N*m (570 kgf*cm, 41 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the difference in length
between the RH and LH tie rod ends and
rack end screws is within 1.5 mm (0.059 in.).
(7) Install the RH and LH boot clips.
SR
SR–8
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
Torx Screw
Screw
Case
1.
PRECAUTION
HINT:
See page RS-1.
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
3.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
6.
REMOVE STEERING PAD
NOTICE:
If the airbag connector is disconnected with the
ignition switch being at ON, DTCs will be recorded.
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench ("Torx" socket wrench
(T=30)), loosen the 2 "torx" screws until the groove
along the screw circumference catches on the
screw case.
F043322E01
(b) Pull out the steering pad from the steering wheel
assembly.
NOTICE:
When removing the steering pad, take care not
to pull the airbag wire harness.
(c) Using a screwdriver, release the lock part of each of
the airbag connectors and disconnect the 2 airbag
connectors.
(d) Disconnect the horn ground harness from the
steering pad.
SR
Horn Ground Harness
Airbag Connector
F043321E01
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
Correct
SR–9
(e) Remove the steering pad.
CAUTION:
• When storing the steering pad, keep the
upper surface of the pad facing upward.
• Never disassemble the steering pad.
Wrong
F043311E01
SST
7.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
(a) without Steering pad switch:
Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the steering wheel assembly set nut.
(c) Mark matchmarks on the steering wheel assembly
and main shaft assembly.
(d) Set the SST on the steering wheel assembly.
(e) Holding the SST to the monkey spanner and turn
the SST, then remove the steering wheel assembly.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
8.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
9.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOT REST
Matchmarks
F043320E01
10. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
11. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-7)
12. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
13. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR
(a) Remove the 3 screws and steering column cover
lower.
14. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
F043298
15. REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the 2 connectors.
(b) Remove the 4 screws and spiral cable.
H042178
SR
SR–10
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
16. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 3 connectors.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and turn signal switch
assembly.
17. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover subassembly No. 1.
F043318
18. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover
assembly rear.
19. REMOVE STEERING SLIDING YOKE
(a) Mark matchmarks on the steering sliding yoke,
steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly No. 2 and
steering intermediate shaft assembly.
(b) Remove the bolt A and bolt B from the steering
sliding yoke.
(c) Slide the steering sliding yoke up and separate it
from the steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly
No. 2.
(d) Pull down the steering sliding yoke from the steering
intermediate shaft assembly to remove.
A
B
Matchmarks
20. REMOVE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
(a) Mark matchmarks on the power steering gear
assembly and steering intermediate shaft subassembly No. 2.
(b) Remove the bolt C and intermediate shaft subassembly No. 2 from the power steering gear
assembly.
C
SR
Matchmarks
F043317E02
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–11
21. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
(a) Remove the heater to register duct.
(b) Remove the 4 clips and steering column hole cover.
22. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect each of the connectors from the steering
column assembly.
(b) Disconnect the wire harness from the steering
column assembly.
(c) Remove the 4 steering column set nuts.
(d) Pull out the steering column assembly with the
intermediate shaft assembly.
Steering Column Hole Cover
F043316E01
DISASSEMBLY
Matchmarks
1.
F043315E01
2.
F043310
REMOVE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the steering shaft
thrust stopper from the steering intermediate shaft
assembly.
(b) Mark matchmarks on the steering column assembly
and steering intermediate shaft.
(c) Pull out the intermediate shaft assembly and
steering shaft thrust stopper from the steering
column assembly.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN BRACKET
ASSEMBLY UPPER (w/ Tilt and Telescopic Steering)
(a) Remove the inverse nut from the telescopic lever.
SR
SR–12
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(b) Mark the matchmarks on the steering telescopic
lever and telescopic lever lock bolt, telescopic lever
lock bolt and steering column upper clamp.
(c) Remove the steering telescopic lever from the
telescopic lever lock bolt.
Matchmarks
F043309E01
(d) Using a 3 mm (0.12 in.) pin punch, mark the center
of the 2 tapered-head bolts.
(e) Using a 3 to 4mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.) drill, drill into the
2 bolts.
(f) Using a screw extractor, remove the 2 tapered-head
bolts, steering column bracket assembly upper,
steering column upper clamp and lock wedge.
Screw
Extractor
C063924E01
SR
3.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN BRACKET
ASSEMBLY UPPER (w/ Tilt Steering)
(a) Using a 3 mm (0.12 in.) pin punch, mark the center
of the 2 tapered-head bolts.
(b) Using a 3 to 4mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.) drill, drill into the
2 bolts.
(c) Using a screw extractor, remove the 2 tapered-head
bolts, steering column bracket assembly upper and
steering column upper clamp.
4.
REMOVE STEERING MAIN SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the 2 tension springs.
SST 09921-00010
Screw Extractor
C090693E01
SST
H041540E01
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and steering column protector.
F043308
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–13
(c) Using SST remove the tension spring.
SST 09921-00010
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and turn signal bracket.
SST
F043307E01
(e) Tilt & telescopic steering:
Using a screwdriver, remove the steering column
No. 1 ring from the steering main shaft.
F043306
(f)
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), remove the 2 tilt
steering bolts.
(g) Pull out the main shaft with the steering column tube
sub-assembly upper from the column tube.
SR
C090875
(h) Bend the joint of the main shaft at right angles,
leaving the cross ball in the No. 2 main shaft subassembly, divide the main shaft into the No. 1 main
shaft with the steering column tube sub-assembly
upper and No. 2 main shaft sub-assembly.
C090846
(i)
SST
H041541E01
Secure the No. 1 main shaft with the steering
column tube sub-assembly upper and SST in a vise.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00051)
SR–14
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(j)
SST
Using SST, compress the spring of the steering
column tube sub-assembly upper.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04010, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04061,
09958-04011)
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
H041542E01
(k) Using snap ring expander, remove the snap ring
and No. 1 main shaft.
(l) Remove the compression spring, bearing thrust
collar and bearing from the No. 1 main shaft.
H041543
SR
F004863
5.
REMOVE STEERING ENERGY ABSORBING PIN
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using pliers, remove the 2 energy absorbing pins.
6.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ENERGY
ABSORBING PLATE
7.
REMOVE STEERING ENERGY ABSORBING PLATE
GUIDE
8.
REMOVE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
NOTICE:
Take care not to use excessive force to prevent the
case from being damaged.
(a) Expand the claw hung on the upper bracket by
approx. 1.0 mm (0.039 in.) using a screwdriver.
(b) Pull the transponder key amplifier toward the rear of
the vehicle with the claw open.
F008822
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
9.
ACC
SR–15
REMOVE IGNITION SWITCH LOCK CYLINDER & KEY
SET
(a) Place the ignition switch lock cylinder assembly at
the ACC position.
(b) Push down the stop pin with a screwdriver and pull
out the ignition switch lock cylinder assembly.
C082969E01
10. REMOVE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the un-lock warning switch assembly
connector from the ignition or start switch assembly.
(b) Remove the un-lock warning switch assembly
toward the rear of the vehicle by pushing up the
center part.
F043296
11. REMOVE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and ignition or starter switch
assembly from the steering column bracket
assembly upper.
SR
F043313
12. REMOVE KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID
(a) Remove the 2 screws and key inter lock solenoid
from the steering column bracket assembly upper.
F043314
SR–16
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID
(a) Install the key inter lock solenoid to the steering
column bracket assembly upper with 2 screws.
2.
INSTALL IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the ignition or starter switch assembly to the
steering column bracket assembly upper with 2
screws.
3.
INSTALL UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the un-lock warning switch assembly to the
steering column bracket assembly upper.
(b) Connect the un-lock warning switch assembly
connector to the ignition or starter switch assembly.
4.
INSTALL IGNITION SWITCH LOCK CYLINDER & KEY
SET
(a) Make sure that the ignition switch lock cylinder
assembly is at the ACC position.
(b) Install the ignition switch lock cylinder assembly.
5.
INSTALL TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
NOTICE:
Take care not to push the amplifier up with excessive
force to prevent it from being damaged.
C090812
(a) Align the transponder key amplifier with the
installation position of the upper bracket with the
amplifier inclined.
(b) Push up the transponder key amplifier and connect
it to the upper bracket.
SR
6.
INSPECT STEERING LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the steering mechanism is activated
when removing the key.
(b) Check that the steering mechanism is deactivated
when inserting the key and turning it to ACC
position.
7.
INSTALL STEERING ENERGY ABSORBING PLATE
GUIDE
8.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ENERGY ABSORBING
PLATE
9.
INSTALL STEERING ENERGY ABSORBING PIN SUBASSEMBLY
C090697
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–17
10. INSTALL STEERING MAIN SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the compression spring, bearing thrust collar
and bearing to the No. 1 main shaft.
(b) Temporarily install the steering column tube subassembly upper to the No. 1 main shaft.
C090850
(c) Secure the No. 1 main shaft with the steering
column tube sub-assembly upper and SST in a vise.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00051)
SST
H041541E01
(d) Using SST, compress the spring of the steering
column tube sub-assembly upper.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04010, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04061,
09958-04011)
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
SST
H041542E01
(e) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring
to the main shaft.
H041543
(f)
C092889
Assemble the No.1 main shaft with the steering
column tube sub-assembly upper and No. 2 main
shaft sub-assembly.
SR
SR–18
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(g) Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), install the 2 tilt
steering bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(h) Install the main shaft with the steering column tube
sub-assembly upper to the column tube.
C090875
(i)
Tilt & telescopic steering:
Install the steering column No. 1 ring to the steering
main shaft.
F043306
(j)
Using SST, install the tension spring.
SST 09921-00010
(k) Install the turn signal bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.7 N*m (58 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
SR
SST
F043307E01
(l)
Install the steering column protector with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 6 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 52 in.*lbf)
F043308
(m) Using SST, install the 2 tension springs.
SST 09921-00010
SST
H041540E01
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–19
11. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN BRACKET ASSEMBLY
UPPER (w/ Tilt and Telescopic Steering)
(a) Temporarily install the lock wedge, steering column
bracket assembly upper and steering column upper
clamp with the 2 new tapered-head bolts.
(b) Tighten the 2 tapered-head bolts until the bolt heads
break off.
C090694
F043301
(c) Make the telescopic mechanism most extended
condition.
(d) After tightening the telescopic lever bolt, perform the
loosening procedure at least 5 times to stabilize.
Torque: Tighten
20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
Loosen
0 N*m (0 kgf*cm, 0 ft.*lbf)
(e) Fix the telescopic lever bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the telescopic lever on the position where the
telescopic locks.
(g) Fix the telescopic lever to the steering column
assembly with a inverse nut.
Torque: 23 N*m (240 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
(h) Install the inverse nut on the steering telescopic
lever.
Torque: 23 N*m (240 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
F043310
12. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN BRACKET ASSEMBLY
UPPER (w/ Tilt Steering)
(a) Temporarily install the steering column bracket
assembly upper and steering column upper clamp
with the 2 new tapered-head bolts.
(b) Tighten the 2 tapered-head bolts until the bolt heads
break off.
C090694
SR
SR–20
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
Matchmarks
F043315E01
SR
13. INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the steering column
assembly and the steering intermediate shaft
assembly.
(b) Install the steering intermediate shaft assembly and
thrust stopper to the steering column assembly with
the bolt.
Torque: 36 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
SR–1
STEERING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR STEERING SYSTEM
(a) Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect
replacement may affect the performance of the
steering system and result in driving hazards.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR SRS AIRBAG
SYSTEM
(a) The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental
Restraint System) such as airbags. Failure to carry
out service operations in the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during
servicing. This may cause a serious accident.
Before servicing (including inspection, replacement,
removal, and installation of parts), be sure to read
the precautionary notices for the Supplemental
Restraint System (See page RS-1).
SR
SR–2
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem. The numbers indicate likely causes of the problem
in order. Check each part in order. If necessary, repair or
replace the faulty parts.
STEERING SYSTEM:
Symptom
Hard steering
Poor return
Excessive free play
SR
Abnormal noise
Suspected Area
See page
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Power steering fluid level (Low)
PS-2
3. Drive belt (Loose)
PS-2
4. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
5. Steering system joints (Worn)
-
6. Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
SP-4
7. Steering column (Binding)
-
8. Power steering vane pump
PS-7
9. Power steering gear
PS-20
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
3. Steering column (Binding)
-
4. Power steering gear
PS-20
1. Steering system joints (Worn)
-
2. Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
SP-4
3. Intermediate shaft, Sliding yoke (Worn)
-
4. Front wheel bearing (Worn)
SP-4
5. Power steering gear
PS-20
1. Power steering fluid level (Low)
PS-2
2. Steering system joints (Worn)
-
3. Power steering vane pump
PS-7
4. Power steering gear
PS-20
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–21
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the steering column assembly with the
steering intermediate shaft assembly with the 4
steering column set nuts.
Torque: 26 N*m (270 kgf*cm, 20 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the wire harness to the steering column
assembly.
(c) Connect each of the connectors to the steering
column assembly.
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
(a) Install the steering column hole cover with the 4
clips.
(b) Install the heater to register duct to the heater unit.
3.
INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
(a) Align the matchmarks on the power steering gear
and steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly No. 2.
(b) Install the steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly
No. 2 to the steering gear box with the bolt C.
Torque: Bolt C
36 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
G021461
A
B
4.
INSTALL STEERING SLIDING YOKE
(a) Align the matchmarks on the steering column and
steering sliding yoke.
(b) Install the steering sliding yoke to the steering
column assembly and slide it upward.
(c) Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft subassembly No. 2 and steering sliding yoke.
(d) Install the sliding yoke to the intermediate shaft subassembly No. 2 with the bolt A and bolt B.
Torque: Bolt A, B
36 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Install the engine under cover assembly rear with
the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
(a) Install the engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1
with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
Matchmarks
C
Matchmarks
F043317E02
SR
SR–22
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
7.
INSTALL TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the turn signal switch assembly with the 3
screws.
(b) Connect the 3 connectors to the turn signal switch
assembly.
8.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Check that the front wheels are facing straight
ahead.
(b) Turn the spiral cable counterclockwise by hand until
it becomes harder to turn.
(c) Then rotate the spiral cable clockwise about 2.5
turns to align the mark.
HINT:
The spiral cable will rotate about 2.5 turns to either
left or right of the center.
(d) Install the spiral cable with the 4 screws.
(e) Connect the 2 connectors to the spiral cable.
9.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
(a) Install the steering column cover upper to the
steering column assembly.
F043318
H042178
10. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR
(a) Install the steering column cover lower to the
steering column assembly.
(b) Install the 3 screws to the steering column cover
upper and lower.
SR
F043298
11. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
12. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
13. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
14. INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOT REST
15. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
16. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the steering wheel and
main shaft assembly.
(b) Install the steering set nut.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(c) without Steering pad switch:
Connect the connector.
17. INSTALL STEERING PAD
NOTICE:
• Never use airbag parts from another vehicle.
When replacing parts, replace with new ones.
• Make sure the steering pad is installed to the
specified torque.
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–23
• If the steering pad has been dropped, or there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case or
connector, replace the steering pad with a new
one.
• When installing the steering pad, take care that
the wirings do not interfere with other parts and
they are not pinched between other parts.
Torx Screw
Screw
Case
F043297E01
(a) Connect the horn ground harness to the steering
pad.
(b) Connect the 2 airbag connectors.
(c) Install the steering pad after confirming that the
circumference groove of "torx" screw is caught on
the screw case.
(d) Using a "torx" socket wrench ("Torx" socket wrench
(T=30)), torque the 2 screws.
Torque: 8.8 N*m (90 kgf*cm, 78 in.*lbf)
18. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
19. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
20. PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
21. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
22. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
HINT:
See page RS-1.
SR
SR–4
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN
COMPONENTS
STEERING PAD
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
50 (510, 37)
STEERING SET NUT
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER NO. 3
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
TORX SCREW
STEERING COLUMN
ASSEMBLY
STEERING
COLUMN
COVER UPR
STEERING SHAFT
THRUST STOPPER
SR
26 (270, 20)
36 (360, 26)
STEERING COLUMN
COVER LWR
STEERING INTERMEDIATE
SHAFT ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
36 (360, 26)
CLIP
STEERING SLIDING YOKE
36 (360, 26)
STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131331E01
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–5
with Tilt Steering Column
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER
INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
FRONT FLOOR FOOT REST
SR
COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
C131332E01
SR–6
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
IGNITION SWITCH LOCK CYLINDER & KEY SET
KEY CYLINDER LIGHT ASSEMBLY
5.7 (58, 50 in.*lbf)
TURN SIGNAL BRACKET
20 (204, 15)
STEERING COLUMN
BRACKET
ASSEMBLY UPPER
KEY INTER
LOCK SOLENOID
SNAP RING
STEERING
COLUMN TUBE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
COMPRESSION SPRING
BEARING
TILT STEERING BOLT
BEARING THRUST
COLLAR
IGNITION OR STARTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
6.0 (60, 52 in.*lbf)
STEERING COLUMN PROTECTOR
NO. 1 MAIN SHAFT
SR
TENSION SPRING
NO. 2 MAIN SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 MAIN SHAFT
NO. 2 MAIN SHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131333E01
SR–7
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
ENERGY ABSORBING PIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
ENERGY ABSORBING GUIDE
ENERGY ABSORBING PLATE
TENSION SPRING
COLUMN TUBE
LOCK WEDGE
with Tilt & Telescopic
with Tilt Steering Column
STEERING COLUMN
NO. 1 RING
STEERING COLUMN UPPER CLAMP
TELESCOPIC LEVER
with Tilt & Telescopic
Steering Column
15 (150, 11)
TILT STEERING
SUPPORT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
23 (240, 17)
TAPERED-HEAD BOLT
STEERING COLUMN UPPER CLAMP
COLUMN TUBE
with Tilt Steering Column
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131334E01
SR
PS–8
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten.
1.
DRAIN POWER STEERING FLUID (See page PS-2)
2.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
3.
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT
(a) Loosen the belt tension by turning the belt tensioner
counterclockwise, and remove the belt.
4.
SEPARATE OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO. 1
(a) Loosen the 2 clips and disconnect the 2 vacuum
hoses.
EM06656
F042719
(b) Loosen the clip and disconnect the hose.
PS
F042720
5.
F042721
SEPARATE PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the union bolt and a gasket, disconnect the
pressure feed tube.
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
6.
PS–9
REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and nut.
(b) Using a "torx" socket (E10), remove the stud bolt.
F042722
DISASSEMBLY
1.
MEASURE VANE PUMP ROTATING TORQUE
(a) Check that the pump rotates smoothly without
abnormal noise.
(b) Using a torque wrench, check the pump rotating
torque.
Torque: Rotating torque
0.28 N*m (2.8 kgf*cm, 2.4 in.*lbf) or less
PS
F004807
2.
REMOVE VANE PUMP PULLEY
(a) Using SST to stop the pulley rotating, loosen the
nut.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
(b) Remove the nut and vane pump pulley from the
vane pump shaft.
3.
REMOVE POWER STEERING SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Remove the bolt and suction port union.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the suction port union.
4.
REMOVE PRESSURE PORT UNION
(a) Remove the pressure port union, flow control valve
and spring.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the pressure port union.
5.
REMOVE VANE PUMP REAR HOUSING
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and vane pump rear housing.
HINT:
If the wave washer and side plate are stuck to the
vane pump rear housing, lightly tap the vane pump
rear housing with a plastic hammer, and remove the
wave washer and side plate.
F004808
PS–10
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
(b) Remove the 2 O-rings from the rear housing.
6.
REMOVE SIDE PLATE AND WAVE WASHER
7.
REMOVE VANE PUMP CAM RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring from the
vane pump shaft.
(b) Remove the cam ring.
8.
REMOVE VANE PUMP ROTOR
(a) Remove the vane pump rotor with the 10 vane
plates.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the plate.
9.
REMOVE VANE PUMP SHAFT
10. REMOVE STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Remove the 2 pins from the vane pump front
housing.
11. REMOVE VANE PUMP HOUSING OIL SEAL
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
(a) Using a screwdriver with vinyl tape wound around
its tip, remove the housing oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vane pump front
housing.
Oil Seal
PS
F001511E01
INSPECTION
1.
Vane Pump Shaft
Bushing
Vane Pump
Front Housing
F001809E02
INSPECT OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a micrometer and a caliper gauge, measure
the oil clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.03 to 0.05 mm (0.0012 to 0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If it is more than the maximum, replace the shaft
and vane pump front housing.
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
Thickness
2.
Height
Length
N000372E07
PS–11
INSPECT VANE PUMP ROTOR AND VANE PUMP
PLATES CLEARANCE
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the height, thickness
and length of the 10 vane plates.
Minimum height:
8.6 mm (0.33858 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.397 mm (0.05500 in.)
Minimum length:
14.991 mm (0.59020 in.)
(b) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the vane pump rotor grove and vane plate.
Maximum clearance:
0.033 mm (0.00130 in.)
If it is more than the maximum, replace the plate
and/or rotor with one having the same mark
stamped on the cam ring.
Inscribed mark:
1, 2, 3, 4, or None
Feeler Gauge
R010282E01
HINT:
There are 5 vane plate lengths with the following
rotor and cam ring marks:
Rotor and cam ring
mark
Vane plate part
number
Vane plate length
mm (in.)
None
44345-26010
14.999 - 15.001
(0.59051 - 0.59059)
1
44345-26020
14.997 - 14.999
(0.59043 - 0.59051)
2
44345-26030
14.995 - 14.997
(0.59035 - 0.59043)
3
44345-26040
14.993 - 14.995
(0.59027 - 0.59035)
4
44345-26050
14.991 - 14.993
(0.59020 - 0.59027)
Incribed Mark
R013897E01
3.
W004759
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Coat the flow control valve with power steering fluid
and check that it falls smoothly into the flow control
valve hole by its own weight.
PS
PS–12
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
(b) Check the flow control valve for leakage. Close one
of the holes and apply compressed air of 392 to 490
kPa (4 to 5 kgf*cm2, 57 to 71 psi) into the opposite
side hole, and confirm that air does not come out
from the end holes.
If necessary, replace the valve with one having the
same letter as inscribed on the front housing.
Inscribed mark:
A, B, C, D, E or F
Compressed Air
F004865E01
Inscribed Mark
F004866E01
4.
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE COMPRESSION
SPRING
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the free length of
the spring.
Minimum free length:
33.2 mm (1.307 in.)
If it is not within the specification, replace the spring.
5.
INSPECT PRESSURE PORT UNION
If the pressure union seat in the pressure port union is
remarkably damaged and it may cause fluid leakage,
replace the pressure port union.
Vernier Caliper
PS
R008702E02
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
PS–13
REASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
When installing, coat the parts indicated by the arrows
with power steering fluid (See page PS-6).
1.
INSTALL VANE PUMP HOUSING OIL SEAL
(a) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(b) Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00320), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing in the
correct direction.
2.
INSTALL VANE PUMP SHAFT
3.
INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Using a plastic hammer, tap the 2 new pins to the
vane pump front housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the pins.
4.
INSTALL VANE PUMP CAM RING
(a) Install the cam ring with the inscribed mark facing
outward.
HINT:
Align the holes of the cam ring with the straight pins.
5.
INSTALL VANE PUMP ROTOR
(a) Install the vane pump rotor with the inscribed mark
facing outward.
(b) Install a new snap ring to the vane pump shaft.
SST
Oil Seal
W004761E01
Inscribed Mark
F004809E01
(c) Install the 10 plates with the round end facing
outward.
(d) Install a new gasket on the front housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the direction of the gasket.
Round End
6.
INSTALL VANE PUMP SIDE PLATE REAR
(a) Align the holes of the plate and 2 straight pins.
7.
INSTALL VANE PUMP REAR HOUSING
(a) Install the wave washer so that its protrusions fit into
the slots in the side plate.
(b) Coat 2 new O-rings with power steering fluid and
install them to the rear housing.
(c) Install the rear housing with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 24 N*m (240 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL PRESSURE PORT UNION
(a) Install the spring to the vane pump front housing.
(b) Install the flow control valve facing the correct
direction (See page PS-3).
F004810E01
F001507
PS
PS–14
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
(c) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and
install it to the pressure port union.
(d) Install the pressure port union.
Torque: 83 N*m (850 kgf*cm, 61 ft.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL POWER STEERING SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and
install it to the suction port union.
(b) Install the suction port union with the bolt.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
10. INSTALL VANE PUMP PULLEY
(a) Install the vane pump pulley and nut to the vane
pump shaft.
(b) Using SST to stop the pulley rotating, torque a new
pulley set nut.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
Torque: 44 N*m (449 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
SST
F004808E01
11. MEASURE VANE PUMP ROTATING TORQUE
(a) Check that the pump rotates smoothly without
abnormal noise.
(b) Using a torque wrench, check the pump rotating
torque.
Torque: Rotating torque
0.28 N*m (2.8 kgf*cm, 2.4 in.*lbf) or less
PS
F004807
INSTALLATION
1.
F042722
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a "torx" socket (E10), install the vane pump
with the stud bolt.
Torque: 22 N*m (224 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the 2 bolts and nut.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
PS–15
2.
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT
(a) Loosen the belt tension by turning the belt tensioner
counterclockwise, and install the bolt.
3.
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the union bolt with a new gasket on each side
of the tube.
Torque: 51 N*m (520 kgf*cm, 38 ft.*lbf)
4.
CONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO. 1
(a) Install the hose with the clip.
EM06656
F042721
PS
F042720
(b) Install the 2 hoses with the 2 clips.
F042719
5.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
6.
ADD POWER STEERING FLUID (See page PS-2)
7.
BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (See page PS-2)
8.
INSPECT POWER STEERING FLUID LEAK (See page
PS-2)
PS–20
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
HINT:
See page RS-1.
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
3.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-9)
6.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER (See
page SR-9)
7.
REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (See
page SR-10)
8.
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE (See page RS-398)
9.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
10. REMOVE REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and rear engine under cover
assembly.
11. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover subassembly No. 1.
12. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BAR
13. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(b) Using SST, separate the tie rod end from the
steering knuckle arm.
SST 09628-62011
PS
SST
F042735E01
14. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Separate the RH side by the same procedures with the
LH side.
SST 09628-62011
15. REMOVE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2 (See page SR-10)
16. DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, loosen the flare nut and disconnect the
pressure feed tube.
SST 09023-12701
SST
F042752E01
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
PS–21
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the pressure feed
tube assembly from frame sub-assembly.
F042728
17. DISCONNECT STEERING GEAR OUTLET RETURN
TUBE
(a) Remove the clip and disconnect the return hose.
F042723
(b) Using SST, remove the outlet return tube.
SST 09023-12701
SST
PS
F042724E01
F042726
18. REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and power steering link
assembly.
NOTICE:
The nut has a detent, so never turn the nut, be
sure to turn the bolt.
HINT:
After the 2 bolts, raise the bolt from the frame, and
slide the gear assembly and the bolt as a unit to the
position where the bolt can be pulled out, and then
remove the bolt.
DISASSEMBLY
1.
SST
F043640E01
FIX POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the 2 turn pressure tubes.
SST 09023-38201
PS–22
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
(b) Using the SST, fix the gear assembly between
aluminum plates in a vise as shown in the
illustration.
SST 09612-00012
SST
F042800E01
2.
REMOVE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Place matchmarks on the tie rod end, lock nut and
rack end.
(b) Loosen the lock nut, remove the tie rod end and lock
nut.
3.
REMOVE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by the same procedures with the
LH side.
4.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP LH
(a) Using pliers and a screwdriver, loosen the clamp.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot.
HINT:
Mark the RH and LH boots.
5.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by the same procedures with the
LH side.
6.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP LH
(a) Using pliers, remove the clip.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot.
7.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by the same procedures with the
LH side.
8.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT LH
9.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT RH
Matchmarks
F006747E01
PS
C061334
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
PS–23
10. REMOVE STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, stake back the
washer.
NOTICE:
Avoid any impact to the steering rack.
ZX09339
SST
F043550E01
(b) Using a spanner to hold the steering rack steady,
and using SST, remove the rack end.
SST 09922-10010
(c) Remove the craw washer.
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010 in the direction shown in
the illustration.
(d) Employ the same manner described above to the
other side.
HINT:
Mark the RH and LH rack ends.
11. REMOVE RACK GUIDE
(a) Using SST, remove the lock nut.
SST 09922-10010
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010 in the direction shown in
the illustration.
SST
PS
F042801E02
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (24 mm), remove the rack
guide spring cap.
(c) Remove the spring and rack guide.
Hexagon
Wrench
F042802E01
12. REMOVE POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Pull out the control valve assembly with the control
valve housing.
(c) Remove the O-ring.
(d) Carefully mount the control valve assembly in a soft
jaw vise.
F043530
PS–24
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
Vinyl Tape
SST
(e) Using SST, remove the bearing guide nut.
SST 09631-20060
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
(f) Remove the O-ring.
(g) Remove the dust cover.
F043531E01
(h) Using SST and a hammer, drive out the oil seal from
the bearing guide nut.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00300), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
(i) Wind vinyl tape to the control valve shaft.
SST
F041410E01
(j)
Vinyl Tape
PS
F043532E01
Using a plastic hammer, tap out the valve assembly
with the bearing guide nut from the control valve
housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
(k) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 teflon rings from
the control valve assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the grooves for the
ring.
(l)
Using a screw extractor, remove the union seat from
the control valve housing.
Screw
Extractor
F043533E01
Oil Seal
SST
SST
Bearing
F043534E01
13. REMOVE POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
UPPER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, press out the bearing and oil seal from
the control valve housing.
SST 09950-70010 (09951-07150), 09950-60010
(09951-00250)
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
PS–25
14. REMOVE CYLINDER END STOPPER
(a) Using SST, remove the stopper.
SST 09631-20120
(b) Remove the O-ring from the stopper.
SST
F043535E02
15. REMOVE STEERING RACK AND OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, press out the steering rack and oil seal.
SST 09950-70010 (09951-07200)
NOTICE:
Take care not to drop the steering rack.
(b) Remove the oil seal from the steering rack.
Press
SST
F043562E01
16. REMOVE STEERING RACK PISTON RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the teflon ring and Oring from the steering rack.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the groove for the ring.
INSPECTION
1.
F043549
ZK08184
INSPECT POWER STEERING RACK
(a) Insert a wire into the vent hole of the steering rack
by 30 mm (1.18 in.), and ensure that the vent hole is
not clogged with grease.
HINT:
If the hole is clogged, the pressure inside the boot
will change after it is assembled and the steering
wheel is turned.
2.
INSPECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5 times as
shown in the figure, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 2 to 4 seconds per 1 turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Torque: Turning
0.29 to 1.96 N*m (2.9 to 20.0 kgf*cm,
2.57 to 17.35 in.*lbf)
3.
INSPECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Inspect the RH side by the same procedures with LH
side.
PS
PS–26
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL STEERING RACK PISTON RING
(a) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and
install it on steering rack.
(b) Expand a new teflon ring with your fingers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to overexpand the teflon ring.
(c) Coat the teflon ring with power steering fluid.
C003629
(d) Install the teflon ring to the steering rack, and settle
it down with your fingers.
N000401
2.
Rack Teeth End
INSTALL POWER STEERING RACK
(a) Coat SST with power steering fluid.
(b) Install SST to the rack.
SST 09631-00350
HINT:
If necessary, scrape the burrs off the rack teeth end
and burnish.
(c) Install the rack into the rack housing.
PS
SST
W002101E01
SST
F005044E01
(d) Coat SST with power steering fluid.
SST 09631-00350
(e) Install SST to the steering rack opposite end.
(f) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid, and
install the oil seal by pushing it without tilting.
NOTICE:
• Make sure to install the oil seal facing in the
correct direction.
• Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
(g) Remove the SST.
SST 09631-00350
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
3.
PS–27
INSTALL CYLINDER END STOPPER
(a) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the stopper.
(b) Using a wooden block and a hammer, drive in the
stopper until it is tightly installed.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the O-ring.
ZX00351
(c) Using SST, torque the stopper.
SST 09631-20120
Torque: 145 N*m (1,479 kgf*cm, 107 ft.*lbf)
SST
F043535E01
4.
SST
INSPECT AIR TIGHTNESS
(a) Install the SST to the unions of the rack housing.
SST 09631-12071 (09633-00010)
(b) Apply 53.33 kPa (400 mmHg, 15.75 in Hg) of
vacuum for about 30 seconds.
(c) Check that there is no change in the vacuum.
If there is change in the vacuum, check the
installation of the oil seals.
PS
F043542E01
5.
Press
SST
SST
Oil Seal
SST
INSTALL POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
UPPER OIL SEAL
(a) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(b) Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00180, 09951-00320,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the oil seal is installed facing in
the correct direction.
F001211E01
Press
(c) Coat a new bearing with molybdenum disulfide
lithium base grease.
(d) Using SST, press in the bearing.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00180, 09951-00320,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
SST
SST
Bearing
Oil Seal
W001753E01
PS–28
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
6.
INSTALL POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
(a) Using a plastic hammer and a sliding handle, lightly
tap in a new union seat.
NOTICE:
Before installing the union seat, remove dust
sticking to the control valve housing.
F043545
(b) Coat the rings with power steering fluid.
(c) Expand 4 new rings with your fingers.
C003629
(d) Install the rings to the control valve assembly, and
settle them down with your fingers.
(e) Carefully slide the tapered end of SST over the
rings until the ring fits to the steering rack.
SST 09631-20081
NOTICE:
Be careful not to overexpand the ring.
SST
PS
Z006085E01
Vinyl Tape
F041420E01
SST
F041421E01
(f) Coat the teflon rings with power steering fluid.
(g) To prevent oil seat lip damage, wind vinyl tape on
the serrated port of the control valve shaft.
(h) Push the valve assembly into the control valve
housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the teflon rings and oil
seal lip.
(i) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the bearing guide nut.
(j) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(k) Using SST and a hammer, drive in the oil seal.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00390), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing in the
correct direction.
(l) Lightly mount the control valve assembly between
aluminum plates in a vise.
(m) To prevent oil seal lip damage, wind vinyl tape on
the pinion part of the control valve shaft.
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
SST
PS–29
(n) Using SST, torque the guide nut.
SST 09631-20060
Torque: 25 N*m (250 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
Vinyl Tape
F043531E01
(o) Using a punch and a hammer, stake the nut.
(p) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid, and
install it to the valve housing.
ZX00357
(q) Apply molybdenum disulfide base grease for the
needle roller bearing inside the rack housing in the
illustrated portion.
Volume of grease applied:
Approximately 2 g (0.07 oz)
(r) Install the control valve assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
Grease Filling
PS
F041423E01
7.
INSTALL RACK GUIDE
(a) Install the rack guide and spring.
(b) Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the rack guide
spring cap.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(c) Using a hexagon wrench (24 mm), temporarily
install the spring cap.
8.
ADJUST TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) To prevent the steering rack teeth from damaging
the oil seal lip, temporarily install the RH and LH
rack ends.
Hexagon
Wrench
F042802E01
PS–30
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
Hexagon
Wrench
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (24 mm), tighten the rack
guide spring cap.
Torque: 25 N*m (250 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(c) Return the cap 30°.
30q
F043642E01
(d) Using SST, turn the control valve shaft right and left
1 or 2 times.
SST 09616-00011
(e) Using a hexagon wrench (24 mm), loosen the cap
until the rack guide spring is not functioning.
SST
F043643E01
(f)
SST
Hexagon
Wrench
PS
F043547E01
Using SST, a torque wrench and a hexagon wrench
(24 mm), tighten the cap until the preload is within
specification.
SST 09616-00011
Torque: Preload in center position (turning)
1.35 to 1.55 N*m (13.77 to 15.81 kgf*cm,
11.94 to 13.71 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Adjustment should be done in the tightening
direction of the spring cap.
HINT:
Adjust the preload so that the turning torque of the
control valve shaft, with the steering rack in the
center position, is within the specification.
(g) Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the lock nut.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(h) Temporarily install the lock nut.
(i)
SST
Fulcrum Length
Hexagon Wrench
F043644E01
Using a hexagon wrench (24 mm), holding the rack
guide spring cap rotating, and using SST, torque the
nut.
SST 09922-10010
Torque: 65 N*m (660 kgf*cm, 48 ft.*lbf) for use
with SST
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010 in the direction shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345
mm (13.58 in.).
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
PS–31
(j)
Recheck the total preload.
Torque: Preload in center position (turning)
1.35 to 1.55 N*m (13.77 to 15.81 kgf*cm,
11.94 to 13.71 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Adjust the preload so that the tuning torque of the
control valve shaft, with the steering rack in the
center position, is within the specification.
(k) Remove the RH and LH rack ends.
SST
F043546E01
Fulcrum
Length
SST
SST
F043646E01
SST
SST
Fulcrum Length
F043645E01
9.
INSTALL STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new claw washer, and temporarily tighten
the rack end.
HINT:
Align the claws of the washer with the steering rack
grooves.
(b) Using SST to hold the steering rack steady, and
using another SST, torque the rack end LH.
SST 09922-10010
Torque: 98 N*m (1,000 kgf*cm, 72 ft.*lbf) for use
with SST
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010 in the direction shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 380
mm (14.9 in.).
(c) Using SST to hold the rack end LH steady, and
using another SST, torque the rack end RH.
SST 09922-10010
Torque: 98 N*m (1,000 kgf*cm, 72 ft.*lbf) for use
with SST
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010 in the direction shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 380
mm (14.9 in.).
(d) Using a brass bar and a hammer, stake the washer.
NOTICE:
Avoid any impact to the rack.
(e) Employ the same manner described above to the
other side.
10. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT LH
(a) Install the boot.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage or twist the boot.
Brass Bar
C035928E01
11. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT RH
HINT:
install the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
PS
PS–32
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
12. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP LH
(a) Using pliers and a screwdriver, install the clamp.
13. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
14. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP LH
(a) Using pliers, install the clip.
C089469
15. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
16. INSPECT POWER STEERING GEAR
(a) Using SST, check that the rack boot stretches
smoothly when the control valve shaft is being
rotated.
SST 09616-00011
SST
F041429E01
(b) Apply MP grease in the illustrated portion.
(c) Install the dust cover.
Grease
Filling
PS
F041433E01
Fulcrum Length
SST
F043641E01
17. INSTALL STEERING TURN PRESSURE TUBE
(a) Using SST, install the 2 turn pressure tubes.
SST 09023-38201
Torque: 23 N*m (230 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf) for use
with SST
HINT:
• Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345
mm (13.58 in.).
• This torque value is effective in case that SST is
parallel to a torque wrench.
18. INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Screw the lock nut and tie rod end onto the rack end
until the matchmarks are aligned.
(b) After adjusting toe-in, torque the nut.
Torque: 88 N*m (897 kgf*cm, 65 ft.*lbf)
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–1
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR STEERING SYSTEM
(a) Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect
replacement could affect the performance of the
steering system and result in hazardous driving.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR SRS AIRBAG
SYSTEM
(a) The vehicle is equipped with SRS (Supplemental
Restraint System), such as airbags. If service
operation is not carried out properly, in a step by
step fashion, sudden deployment of the airbags
may result in serious injury. Before servicing
(including removal or installation of parts, inspection
or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary
notice for the supplemental restraint system (See
page RS-1).
PS
PS–2
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem. The numbers indicate likely causes of the problem
in descending order. Check each part in order. Repair or
replace parts as necessary.
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
Hard steering
Poor return
Excessive free play
Abnormal noise
PS
See page
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Power steering fluid level (Low)
PS-2
3. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
4. Steering arm ball joints (Worn)
-
5. Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
SP-4
6. Steering column (Binding)
-
7. Power steering vane pump
PS-10
8. Power steering gear
PS-25
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
TW-1
2. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-4
3. Steering column (Binding)
-
4. Power steering gear
PS-25
1. Steering system joints (Worn)
-
2. Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
SP-4
3. Intermediate shaft, Sliding yoke (Worn)
-
4. Front wheel bearing (Worn)
SP-4
5. Power steering gear
PS-25
1. Power steering fluid level (Low)
PS-2
2. Steering system joints (Worn)
-
3. Power steering vane pump
PS-10
4. Power steering gear
PS-25
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords, etc.
If any defect is found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. Replace the belt if there are any
missing ribs.
2.
BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(a) Check the fluid level.
(b) Jack up the front of the vehicle and support it with
stands.
(c) Turn the steering wheel.
(1) With the engine stopped, turn the wheel slowly
from lock to lock several times.
(d) Lower the vehicle.
(e) Start the engine.
(1) Run the engine at idle for a few minutes.
F040449
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–3
(f)
Turn the steering wheel.
(1) With the engine idling, turn the wheel left or
right to the full lock position and keep it there
for 2 to 3 seconds, then turn the wheel to the
opposite full lock position and keep it there for 2
to 3 seconds.*1
(2) Repeat (*1) several times.
(g) Stop the engine.
Normal
(h) Check for foaming or emulsification.
Especially, if the system has to be held twice
because of foaming or emulsification, check for fluid
leaks in the system.
(i) Check the fluid level.
Abnormal
F040897E06
3.
F040898
Noemal
Abnormal
F040897E07
CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(a) Keep the vehicle horizontal.
(b) With the engine stopped, check the fluid level in the
reservoir.
If necessary, add fluid.
Fluid:
ATF DEXRON II or III
HINT:
If the fluid is hot, check that the fluid level is within
the HOT range. If the fluid is cold, check that the
fluid level is within the COLD range.
(c) Start the engine and run at idle.
(d) Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several
times to raise fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature:
75 to 80°C (167 to 176°F)
(e) Check for foaming or emulsification.
If foaming or emulsification is identified, bleed the
power steering system.
PS
PS–4
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(f)
With the engine idling, measure the fluid level in the
reservoir.
(g) Stop the engine.
(h) Wait a few minutes and remeasure the fluid level in
the reservoir.
Maximum fluid level rise:
About 5 mm (0.20 in.)
If a problem is found, bleed the power steering
system.
(i) Check the fluid level.
5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
Engine Idling
Engine Stopped
R011786E08
4.
CHECK STEERING FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the pressure feed tube assembly (See
page PS-8).
(b) Connect SST as shown in the illustration.
SST 09640-10010 (09641-01010, 09641-01030,
09641-01060)
NOTICE:
Check that the valve of the SST is in the open
position.
(c) Bleed the power steering system.
(d) Start the engine and run at idle.
(e) Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several
times to raise fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature:
75 to 80°C (167 to 176°F)
Attachment
PS
SST
IN
OUT
Pressure Feed Tube Assembly
Attachment
F004813E01
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(f)
Oil
Reservoir
PS Gear
Closed
PS Vane
Pump
SST
Z015498E06
Open
PS Vane
Pump
SST
With the engine idling, close the valve of the SST
and observe the reading on the SST.
Minimum fluid pressure:
8,336 kPa (85 kgf/cm2, 1,209 psi)
NOTICE:
• Do not keep the valve closed for more than 10
seconds.
• Do not allow the fluid temperature to become
too high.
If not within the specified range, check for fluid leaks
and replace parts as necessary.
(g) With the engine idling, fully open the valve.
(h) Measure the fluid pressure at engine speeds of
1,000 rpm and 3,000 rpm.
Difference in fluid pressure:
490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) or less
NOTICE:
Do not turn the steering wheel.
If not within the specified range, check for fluid leaks
and replace parts as necessary.
Oil
Reservoir
PS Gear
PS–5
Z015499E06
(i)
With the engine idling and the valve fully opened,
turn the steering wheel left or right to the full lock
position. Observe the reading on the SST.
Minimum fluid pressure:
8,336 kPa (85 kgf/cm2, 1,209 psi)
NOTICE:
• Do not keep the steering wheel in the full lock
position for more than 10 seconds.
• Do not allow the fluid temperature to become
too high.
If not within the specified range, check for fluid leaks
and replace parts as necessary.
(j) Disconnect the SST.
SST 09640-10010 (09641-01010, 09641-01030,
09641-01060)
(k) Connect the pressure feed tube assembly to the
vane pump assembly (See page PS-14).
(l) Bleed the power steering system.
Oil
Reservoir
Lock Position
PS Gear
Open
PS Vane
Pump
SST
Z015500E06
5.
C130081
CHECK STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Center the steering wheel.
(b) Remove the steering pad (See page RS-388).
(c) Start the engine and run at idle.
(d) Measure the steering effort in both directions.
Torque: Steering effort (Reference)
6.0 N*m (60 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf) or less
HINT:
Check tire type, pressure and road surface before
making your diagnosis.
If not within the specified range, check the power
steering system (See page PS-1).
PS
PS–6
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(e) Tighten the steering wheel set nut.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the steering pad (See page RS-388).
PS
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
PS–33
19. INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the power steering link assembly with the 2
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 100 N*m (1,020 kgf*cm, 74 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
The nut has a detent, so never turn the nut, be
sure to turn the bolt.
HINT:
Insert the bolt and slide it with the gear assembly as
a unit and then install the bolt on the frame.
2.
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT
3.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION
4.
CONNECT STEERING GEAR OUTLET RETURN
TUBE
(a) Using SST, connect the outlet return tube.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf) for use
with SST
HINT:
• Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300
mm (11.81 in.).
• This torque value is effective in case that SST is
parallel to a torque wrench.
F042726
Fulcrum
Length
SST
F043639E01
(b) Install the hose with the clip.
F042723
5.
F042728
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the pressure feed tube assembly to the frame
sub-assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 28 N*m (286 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
PS
PS–34
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
(b) Using SST, tighten the flare nut and connect the
pressure feed tube.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf) for use
with SST
HINT:
• Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300
mmm (11.81 in.).
• This torque value is effective in case that SST is
parallel to a torque wrench
Fulcrum
Length
SST
F043638E01
6.
TIGHTEN STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2 (See page SR-20)
7.
CONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle arm.
(b) Install the nut and cotter pin.
Torque: 91 N*m (928 kgf*cm, 67 ft.*lbf)
8.
CONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side by the same procedures with the LH
side.
9.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
(a) Install the engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1
with the 4 bolts.
10. INSTALL REAR ENGINE UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear engine under cover assembly with
the 6 bolts.
PS
11. INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 110 N*m (1,122 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
12. PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
13. INSTALL TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (See
page SR-21)
14. INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE (See page RS-398)
15. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER (See
page SR-21)
16. CENTER SPIRAL CABLE (See page RS-399)
17. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-21)
18. INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT (See
page SR-2)
19. INSTALL STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
20. INSPECT STEERING PAD (See page RS-389)
21. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page RS-389)
22. ADD POWER STEERING FLUID (See page PS-2)
23. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (See page PS-2)
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
PS–35
24. CHECK POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKAGE (See
page PS-2)
25. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
HINT:
See page SP-4.
PS
PS–6
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
VANE PUMP
POWER STEERING
STEERING
COMPONENTS
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
VACUUM HOSE
51 (520, 38)
UNION BOLT
GASKET
CLIP
PS
PRESSURE FEED
TUBE ASSEMBLY
OIL RESERVOIR TO
PUMP HOSE NO. 1
CLIP
22 (224, 16)
STUD BOLT
VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
VANE PUMP V BELT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C131335E01
PS–7
POWER STEERING – VANE PUMP
83 (850, 61)
PRESSURE PORT UNION
O-RING
FLOW CONTROL VALVE
POWER STEERING
SUCTION PORT UNION
SPRING
GASKET
O-RING
13 (130, 9)
VANE PUMP HOUSING
OIL SEAL
44 (449, 32)
VANE PUMP
HOUSING FRONT
VANE PUMP SHAFT
VANE PUMP PULLEY
VANE PUMP
REAR HOUSING
VANE PUMP CAM RING
STRAIGHT PIN
PS
SNAP RING
24 (240, 17)
O-RING
VANE PUMP ROTOR
WAVE WASHER
X 10
SIDE PLATE
VANE PLATE
STRAIGHT PIN
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Power steering fluid
C131336E01
PS–16
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
POWER STEERING LINK
POWER STEERING
STEERING
COMPONENTS
RETURN HOSE
28 (286, 21)
PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSEMBLY
STEERING GEAR
OUTLET RETURN TUBE
COTTER PIN
41 (449, 32)
*42 (428, 31)
91 (928, 67)
41 (428, 32)
*42 (428, 31)
100 (1,020, 74)
COTTER PIN
91 (928, 67)
70 (714, 52)
POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
70 (714, 52)
BUSH
PS
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
BRACKET
BUSH
BRACKET
40 (408, 30)
40 (408, 30)
X6
REAR ENGINE UNDER
COVER ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
X4
Non-reusable part
* For use with SST
ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 1
C131337E01
PS–17
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
TIE ROD END
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
88 (897, 65)
STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP RH
STEERING RACK BOOT RH
103 (1,050, 76)
*98 (1,000, 72)
STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLAW WASHER
STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP RH
145 (1,479, 107)
CYLINDER END STOPPER
O-RING
BUSHING
PS
OIL SEAL
O-RING
TEFLON RING
POWER STEERING RACK
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease
Power Steering Fluid
* For use with SST
C131338E01
PS–18
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
POWER STEERING RACK HOUSING SUB-ASSEMBLY
103 (1,050, 76)
*98 (1,000, 72)
STEERING RACK END
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLAW WASHER
STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP LH
PS
STEERING RACK BOOT LH
STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP LH
88 (897, 65)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
Non-reusable part
* For use with SST
C131569E01
PS–19
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING LINK
25 (250, 18)
*23 (230, 17)
TURN PRESSURE TUBE
CONTROL VALVE
HOUSING
18 (184, 13)
25 (250, 18)
*23 (230, 17)
DUST COVER
18 (184, 13)
O-RING
OIL SEAL
UNION SEAT
O-RING
POWER STEERING
CONTROL VALVE
UPPER OIL SEAL
25 (250, 18)
BEARING
BEARING GUIDE NUT
TEFLON RING
POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
69 (700, 51)
*65 (660, 48)
PS
LOCK NUT
25 (250, 18)
RACK GUIDE
SPRING CAP
RACK GUIDE SPRING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease
RACK HOUSING
RACK GUIDE
Precoated part
Power steering Fluid
* For use with SST
C131339E01
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–3
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY ASSEMBLY
(MARKING: HEATER)
- COOLER RELAY ASSEMBLY
(MARKING: MG CLT)
- HEATER FUSE
- ECU-B FUSE
CONDENSER
- HEATER NO. 2 FUSE
PRESSURE SWITCH
AC
THERMISTOR ASSEMBLY
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
- MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
- COMPRESSOR LOCK SENSOR
C119744E01
AC–4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR ASSEMBLY
ECM
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
DRIVER SIDE J/B
COOLER THERMISTOR
- IG1 FUSE
(ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
C119745E05
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–5
BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY (AIR
INLET DAMPER CONTROL SERVO MOTOR)
COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1
(EVAPORATOR TEMP. SENSOR)
BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
MODE DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSEMBLY (AIR
OUTLET DAMPER CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR)
DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY (*1)
(AIR MIX DAMPER CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR)
DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(AIR MIX DAMPER CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR)
(*1): Limited grade only
HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSEMBLY
C119746E01
AC
AC–6
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
The intelligent tester can be used in steps 2, 5, 6, 7 and 10.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CHECK AND CLEAR DTCS
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
SYMPTOM DOES NOT OCCUR (GO TO STEP
4)
SYMPTOM OCCURS (GO TO STEP 5)
4
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
5
DTC CHECK (OTHER THAN MULTIPLEX DTC)
AC
TROUBLE CODE (GO TO STEP 6)
NORMAL SYSTEM CODE (GO TO STEP 7)
6
DTC CHART
GO TO STEP 8
7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
8
NEXT
ACTUATOR CHECK
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
9
AC–7
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
10
TERMINALS OF ECU
NEXT
11
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
12
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
13
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
AC
AC–8
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If the normal code is displayed during DTC check although
the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each problem
symptom in the order given in the table below, and proceed to
the relevant troubleshooting.
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM:
Symptom
Whole functions of the A/C system does not operate.
Air Flow Control: No blower operation
Air Flow Control: No blower control
Temperature Control: No cool air comes out.
AC
Temperature Control: No warm air comes out.
Temperature Control: Output air is warmer or cooler
than the set temperature or response is slow.
Suspected area
See page
1. IG power source circuit
AC-92
2. Heater control panel power source circuit
AC-86
3. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
1. Heater relay circuit
AC-88
2. Blower motor circuit
AC-78
3. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
Blower motor circuit
AC-78
1. Volume of refrigerant
AC-99
2. Drive belt tension (for 1GR-FE)
EM-6
3. Refrigerant pressure
AC-99
4. Compressor lock sensor circuit
AC-42
5. Compressor circuit
AC-82
6. Pressure switch circuit
AC-44
7. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-73
8. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-64
9. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-60
10. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-50
11. Room temp. sensor circuit
AC-26
12. Ambient temp. sensor circuit
AC-29
13. Vehicle speed signal circuit
AC-76
14. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
1. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-73
2. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-64
3. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-60
4. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-50
5. Ambient temp. sensor circuit
AC-29
6. Vehicle speed signal circuit
AC-76
7. Room temp. sensor circuit
AC-26
8. Evaporator temp. sensor circuit
AC-32
9. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
10. Heater radiator
AC-117
1. Room temp. sensor circuit
AC-26
2. Ambient temp. sensor circuit
AC-29
3. Vehicle speed signal circuit
AC-76
4. Solar sensor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-47
5. Solar sensor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-38
6. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-60
7. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-50
8. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-73
9. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-64
10. Engine coolant temperature communication circuit
AC-35
11. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
AC–9
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symptom
Temperature Control: No temperature control (only
Max. cool or Max. warm)
No air inlet control
No air outlet control
Suspected area
See page
1. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-73
2. Air mix control servo motor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-64
3. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Driver side) (*1)
AC-60
4. Air mix damper position sensor circuit (Passenger side)
AC-50
5. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
1. Air inlet damper control servo motor circuit
AC-67
2. Air inlet damper position sensor circuit
AC-54
3. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
1. Air outlet damper control servo motor circuit
AC-70
2. Air outlet damper position sensor circuit
AC-57
3. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
1. Compressor circuit
AC-82
2. LIN communication circuit
AC-97
Blinking of A/C indicator
Compressor lock sensor circuit
AC-42
Set temperature value displayed does not much up
with operation of temperature control switch.
LIN communication circuit
AC-97
Brightness does not change when rheostat volume or
light control switch is turned.
1. Illumination light system
-
2. Heater control panel
-
Unable to access the diagnosis mode.
LIN communication circuit
AC-97
DTC not recorded. Set mode is cleared when IG
switch is turned off.
1. Back-up power source circuit
AC-95
2. A/C amplifier
-
Engine idle up does not occur, or is continuous.
(*1): Limited grade only
AC
AC–37
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
Engine Coolant Temperature Communication
Circuit
14
DESCRIPTION
This circuit converts the resistance of the engine coolant temperature sensor into a pulse signal and
transmits to the A/C amplifier.
DTC No.
Detection Item
14
Trouble Area
Open or short in A/C amplifier and ECM circuit
•
•
•
ECM
Harness or connector between ECM and A/C
amplifier assembly
A/C amplifier assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
14
THWO E7
Center J/B
L-B
H
J32
J/C
E
J31
L-B
C
3D
C
3D
L-B
7
A16 TWI
A/C
Amplifier
I033593E01
AC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Check that DTC P0115 is not output.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC P0115 is not output.
A
DTC P0115 is output.
B
B
A
GO TO ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
AC–38
2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM (THWO)
(a) Remove the ECM with the connectors still connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
THWO
A053769E16
5 V/Division
“A”
“A”
GND
0.1 sec./Division
(c) Measure the waveform between terminal THWO of the
ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Pulse generation
HINT:
• The correct waveform is as shown.
• The waveform frequency "A" becomes longer as the
engine coolant temperature becomes higher, as
shown in the chart.
I031455E04
Engine coolant temperature
Frequency "A"
Below 30°C (86°F)
16 ms
Approx. 75°C (167°F)
102 ms
90°C to 100°C (194°F to 212°F)
262 ms
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
AC
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the ECM and the A/C amplifier (See
page IN-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (when checking using PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (when checking using DTC)
B
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–39
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–40
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
21
Solar Sensor Circuit (Passenger Side)
DESCRIPTION
A photodiode in the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor detects solar radiation and sends signals to the A/C
amplifier.
Resistance of Photodiode
High
Low
Strong
Weak
Strength of Solar Radiation
E107008E01
DTC No.
Detection Item
21
Trouble Area
•
•
Open or short in solar sensor circuit
•
Cooler (solar sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (solar
sensor) thermistor and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
AC
A/C Amplifier
Center J/B
P (*1)
P (*2)
5
IG1
6
IG1
B
3B
P (*1)
B
3B
P
1
A17 S5
P (*2)
A20 Cooler (Solar Sensor) Thermistor
V-G (*2)
1
2
5
IG1
V-G (*2)
4
IG1
B-O (*1)
26 (*1)
12 (*2)
A16 TSPA (*1)
TS (*2)
A21 Cooler (Solar Sensor) Thermistor
P (*1)
B-O (*1)
1
(*1): Limited
2
(*2): SR5 Grade
I033596E01
AC–41
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If the check is performed in a dark place, DTC 21, 24 (solar sensor circuit abnormal) may be output.
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TS, TSP, S5)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
SR-5 grade:
S5 (-)
TS (+)
I033523E04
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Limited grade:
S5 (-)
TSPA (+)
I033523E05
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A17-1 (S5) - A16-26
(TSPA) (*1)
Ignition switch ON
0.8 to 4.3 V
A17-1 (S5) - A16-12 (TS)
(*2)
Ignition switch ON
0.8 to 4.3 V
*1: Limited
*2: SR5 Grade
HINT:
• Use an incandescent light for inspection. Bring it
within 30 cm (11.8 in.) of the cooler (solar sensor)
thermistor.
• Move the light away from the sensor voltage
increases
• Move the light closer to the sensor voltage decreases
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a) Remove the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
SR-5 grade:
2
1
I033907E01
AC
AC–42
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the
cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
Standard resistance
Limited grade:
2
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
2-1
Sensor is subject to
electric light
Except ∞ Ω
2-1
Sensor is covered with
a cloth
∞ Ω (No continuity)
1
I033908E01
NOTICE:
The connection procedure for using a digital tester
such as an electrical tester is shown above. When
using an analog tester, connect the negative (-) lead
to terminal 2 and positive (+) lead to terminal 1 of the
cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
HINT:
• As the inspection light is moved away from the
sensor, the resistance increases.
• Use an incandescent light for inspection. Bring it
within 30 cm (11.8 in.) of the cooler (solar sensor)
thermistor.
NG
REPLACE COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR)
THERMISTOR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
AC
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor
and the A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 21 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 21 is output.
A
DTC 21 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–43
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–1
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
Because the compressor operates at high voltages, wear
electric insulated gloves and pull out the service plug to
cut the high-voltage circuit before inspection.
1.
2.
DO NOT HANDLE REFRIGERANT IN AN ENCLOSED
AREA OR NEAR AN OPEN FLAME.
ALWAYS WEAR EYE PROTECTION
Charging
Cylinder
AC02810E02
3.
AC02811
4.
5.
Wrong
Okay
LO
LO
HI
6.
HI
7.
N011084E04
8.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO GET LIQUID REFRIGERANT
IN YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR SKIN
If liquid refrigerant gets in your eyes or on your skin:
(a) Wash the area with lots of cold water.
CAUTION:
Do not rub your eyes or skin.
(b) Apply clean petroleum jelly to the skin.
(c) Go immediately to a hospital or see a physician for
professional treatment.
NEVER HEAT CONTAINER OR EXPOSE IT TO OPEN
FLAME
BE CAREFUL NOT TO DROP CONTAINER OR APPLY
PHYSICAL SHOCKS TO IT
DO NOT OPERATE COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
ENOUGH REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
If there is not enough refrigerant in the A/C system, oil
lubrication will be insufficient and the compressor may
be damaged.
Necessary care should be taken to avoid this.
DO NOT OPEN HIGH PRESSURE MANIFOLD VALVE
WHILE COMPRESSOR IS OPERATING
Open and close only the low pressure valve. If the high
pressure values are opened, refrigerant flows in the
reverse direction causing the charging cylinder to
rupture.
If the high pressure valve is opened, refrigerant flows in
the reverse direction causing the charging cylinder to
rupture.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVERCHARGE SYSTEM WITH
REFRIGERANT
If refrigerant is overcharged, it causes problems such as
insufficient cooling, poor fuel economy, engine
overheating, etc.
AC
AC–2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
9.
AC
GENERAL PRECAUTION
(a) While using the battery during inspection, do not
bring the positive and negative tester probes too
close to each other as a short circuit may occur.
AC–44
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
22
Compressor Lock Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This sensor sends 4 pulses par engine revolution to the A/C amplifier. If the ratio of the compressor speed
divided by the engine speed is smaller than a predetermined value, the A/C amplifier turns the
compressor off, and the indicator flashes at about 1 sec. intervals.
DTC No.
22
Detection Item
All conditions below are detected for 3 sec. or more.
(a) Engine speed: 450 rpm or more.
(b) Ratio between engine and compressor speed
deviates 20 % or more in comparison with normal
operation.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Cooler compressor assembly
Compressor drive belt
Compressor lock sensor
Harness or connector between compressor lock
sensor and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
W-G
1
2
IM2
W-G
19
A16 LOCK
3
IM2
Y-G
6
A16 SG
A2
A/C Lock Sensor (Cooler
Compressor Assembly)
2
Y-G
I045660E01
AC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (LOCK)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the A/C switch ON.
SG
LOCK
I033523E06
AC–45
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Waveform:
200 mV
/Division
GND
10 msec./Division
I031459E10
(d) Measure the waveform between terminal LOCK (A1619) and terminal SG (A16-6) of the A/C amplifier.
OK:
Waveform appears as shown in the illustration.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from DTC)
B
OK (When checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
2
INSPECT COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector from the cooler compressor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
A2
E005280E16
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A2-1 - A2-2
at 20°C (68°F)
165 to 205 Ω
NG
REPLACE COOLER COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
AC
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the cooler compressor assembly and
the A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AC–46
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
23
Pressure Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The pressure switch sends appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier when the A/C refrigerant pressure
drops too low or rises too high. When the A/C amplifier receives these signals, it outputs signals via the A/
C amplifier to switch OFF the compressor relay and turn OFF the magnetic clutch.
DTC No.
Detection Item
•
•
23
Trouble Area
•
•
Open in pressure sensor circuit
Abnormal refrigerant pressure
below 196 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi)
•
•
over 3,140 kPa (32.0 kgf/cm2, 455 psi)
Pressure switch
Harness or connector between pressure switch and
A/C amplifier
Refrigerant pipe line
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
J1
J/C
Y-R
D
Y-R
E
5
IN1
LG-R
1
D
Y-R
E
A/C Amplifier
P3
Pressure SW
2
Driver Side J/B
IG1
20
1E
LG-R
9
A17 PSW
I18
Ignition SW
2
1C
L-Y
4 IG1
AM1 2
Engine Room R/B
B
AC
ALT
2
AM1
21
1
2
2
2
W-L
2
B
Battery
I045661E02
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–47
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE
(a) Set the manifold gauge (See page AC-99).
(b) Read the manifold gauge pressure when these
conditions are established.
Test conditions:
• Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set at
RECIRC is 30 to 35°C (86 to 95°F)
• Engine running at 1,500 rpm
• Blower speed control switch at "HI" position
• Temperature control dial at "COOL" position
• Air conditioning switch ON
• Fully open doors
Standard:
Pressure on high pressure side:
1.37 to 1.57 MPa (13.9 to 16.0 kgf*cm2, 198 to 228
psi)
HINT:
If the refrigerant pressure is below 196 kPa (2.0 kgf*cm2,
28 psi), the refrigerant amount in the air conditioning
cycle may have decreased significantly for reasons such
as a gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING
CYCLE
OK
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
I040669
AC
(a) Disconnect the pressure switch connector.
(b) Connect terminals 1 and 2 of the connector of the
pressure switch on the vehicle wire harness side using a
service wire.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) Turn the air conditioning switch on and check that the
magnetic clutch is turned on.
(e) Check that the magnetic clutch is turned off when
disconnecting terminals 1 and 2 (that are connected in
the prior step).
OK:
Terminals 1 and 2 connected:
the compressor is operated
Terminals 1 and 2 disconnected:
the compressor is not operated
NG
Go to step 3
AC–48
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCH
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SWITCH - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the pressure switch and the A/C
amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 23 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 23 is output.
A
DTC 23 is not output. (Checking from the DTC)
B
DTC 23 is not output. (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
C
AC
B
SYSTEM IS OK
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–49
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
24
Solar Sensor Circuit (Driver Side)
DESCRIPTION
A photodiode in the solar sensor detects solar radiation and sends signals to the A/C amplifier.
Resistance of Photodiode
High
Low
Strong
Weak
Strength of Solar Radiation
E107008E01
HINT:
This DTC is indicated only for limited grade (right/left independent temperature control system).
DTC No.
24
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
•
Open or short in solar sensor circuit circuit
•
Cooler (Solar sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (solar
sensor) thermistor and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Limited grade:
A/C Amplifier
Center J/B
P
5
IG1
B
3B
P
B
3B
P
AC
1
A17 S5
A21
A/C Solar Sensor
R
1
3
6
IG1
R
12
A16 TSDR
I033594E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If the check is performed in a dark place, DTC 21, 24 (solar sensor circuit abnormal) may be output.
AC–50
1
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TS, S5)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TSDR (+)
I033523E07
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A17-1 (S5) - A16-12
(TSDR)
Ignition switch ON
0.8 to 4.3 V
HINT:
• Use an incandescent light for inspection. Bring it
within 30 cm (11.8 in.) of the cooler (solar sensor)
thermistor.
• Move the light away from the sensor voltage
increases
• Move the light closer to the sensor voltage decreases
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a) Remove the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 3 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the
cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
Standard resistance
AC
3
1
I033908E02
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-1
Sensor is subject to
electric light
Except ∞ Ω
3-1
Sensor is covered with
a cloth
∞ Ω (No continuity)
NOTICE:
The connection procedure for using a digital tester
such as an electrical tester is shown above. When
using an analog tester, connect the negative (-) lead
to terminal 3 and positive (+) lead to terminal 1 of the
cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
HINT:
• As the inspection light is moved away from the
sensor, the resistance increases.
• Use an incandescent light for inspection. Bring it
within 30 cm (11.8 in.) of the cooler (solar sensor)
thermistor.
AC–51
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR)
THERMISTOR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor
and the air conditioning amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 24 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 24 is output.
A
DTC 24 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–52
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
Air Mix Damper Position Sensor Circuit (Passenger Side)
31
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the position of the air mix damper and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C
amplifier. The position sensor is built into the damper servo sub-assembly (air mix control servo motor).
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E01
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
31
Open or short in air mix damper position sensor circuit
•
•
AC
Damper servo sub-assembly (Air mix damper
position sensor)
Harness or connector between damper servo subassembly (air mix damper position sensor) and A/C
amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Damper Servo Sub-assembly
(Air Mix Damper Position Sensor)
2
2
A28 A26
(*1) (*2)
3
A/C Amplifier
Center J/B
P
B
3B
B
3B
P
1
A17 S5
3
A28 A26
(*1) (*2)
(*1): Limited
1
1
A28 A26
(*1) (*2)
Y-G
L-W (*1)
L-O (*2)
6
A16 SG
23 (*1)
25 (*2)
A16 TPPA (*1)
TP (*2)
(*2): SR5 Grade
I033598E01
AC–53
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TP, TPDR, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
SR-5 grade:
SG (-)
TP (+)
I033523E08
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Change the set temperature to activate the air mix
damper.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage:
SR-5 grade
Limited grade:
SG (-)
TPPA (+)
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-25 (TP) - A16-6 (SG)
Ignition switch ON
MAX. HOT position
0.5 to 1.8 V
A16-25 (TP) - A16-6 (SG)
Ignition switch ON
MAX. COLD position
3.5 to 5.5 V
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-23 (TPPA) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
MAX. HOT position
0.5 to 1.8 V
A16-23 (TPPA) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
MAX. COLD position
3.5 to 5.5 V
I033523E09
Limited grade
HINT:
As the set temperature increases, the voltage decreases
gradually without interruption.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the damper servo sub-assembly.
AC
AC–54
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the connector from the damper servo subassembly.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
I030157
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-2
MAX. COLD position
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
3-2
MAX. HOT position
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
MAX. COLD
MAX. HOT
I033526E02
Resistance (kΩ)
3.4 to 6.2
Arm position
(e) As the damper servo sub-assembly moves from COLD
side to HOT side, the resistance decreases gradually
without interruption.
HINT:
For details regarding operation of the servo motor (See
page AC-67).
NG
0.8 to 1.6
MAX. COOL
MAX. HOT
REPLACE DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
I030161E01
AC
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR MIX DAMPER POSITION SENSOR - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short in the harness and the
connector between the damper servo sub-assembly (air
mix damper position sensor) and the A/C amplifier (See
page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 31 is not output again.
AC–55
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 31 is output.
A
DTC 31 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–56
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
32
Air Inlet Damper Position Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the position of the air inlet damper and sends appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier.
The position sensor is built into the blower damper servo sub-assembly (air inlet damper control servo
motor).
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E01
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
32
Open or short in air inlet damper position sensor circuit
•
•
AC
Blower damper servo sub-assembly (Air inlet
damper position sensor)
Harness or connector between blower damper
servo sub-assembly (air inlet damper position
sensor) and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
A25 Blower Damper Servo Sub-assembly
(Air Inlet Damper Position Sensor)
P
1
B
3B
B
3B
Y-G
3
A/C Amplifier
Center J/B
2
P-B
P
1
A17 S5
6
A16 SG
16
A16 TPI
I033597E01
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–57
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TPI, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Change the set RECIRCULATION/FRESH to activate
the blower damper.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TPI (+)
I033523E10
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-16 (TPI) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
RECIRCULATION
position
3.5 to 4.5 V
A16-16 (TPI) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
FRESH position
0.5 to 1.8 V
HINT:
As the blower damper is moved from RECIRCULATION
side to FRESH side, the voltage decreases gradually
without interruption.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the blower damper servo sub-assembly.
(b) Disconnect the connector from the blower damper servo
sub-assembly.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
I030157
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
AC
AC–58
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
RECIRCULATION
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-2
RECIRCULATION
position
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
3-2
FRESH position
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
FRESH
I033528E01
(e) As the blower damper servo sub-assembly moves from
FRESH side to RECIRCULATION side, the resistance
decreases gradually without interruption.
HINT:
For details regarding operation of the servo motor (See
page AC-70).
Resistance (kΩ)
3.4 to 6.2
0.8 to 1.6
RECIRCULATION
NG
FRESH
REPLACE BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
I030159E02
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR INLET DAMPER POSITION SENSOR - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the blower damper servo subassembly (air inlet damper position sensor) and the A/C
amplifier (See page IN-38).
AC
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 32 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 32 is output.
A
DTC 32 is not output.
B
B
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
SYSTEM IS OK
AC–59
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
33
Air Outlet Damper Position Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the position of the air outlet damper and sends appropriate signals to the A/C
amplifier. The position sensor is built into the mode damper servo sub-assembly (air outlet servo motor).
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E01
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
Open or short in air outlet damper position sensor
circuit
33
•
•
Mode damper servo sub-assembly (Air outlet
damper position sensor)
Harness or connector between mode damper servo
sub-assembly (air outlet damper position sensor)
and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
A29 Mode Damper Servo Sub-assembly
(Air Outlet Damper Position Sensor)
P
2
Center J/B
B
3B
B
3B
Y-G
3
1
LG-R
AC
A/C Amplifier
P
1
A17 S5
6
A16 SG
17
A16 TPO
I033597E02
AC–60
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TPO, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Change the set air flow mode to activate the mode
damper servo sub-assembly.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TPO (+)
I033523E11
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-17 (TPO) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
FACE position
3.5 to 4.5 V
A16-17 (TPO) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
DEF position
0.5 to 1.5 V
HINT:
As the mode damper is moved from FACE side to DEF
side, the voltage decreases gradually without
interruption.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the mode damper servo sub-assembly.
(b) Disconnect the connector from the mode damper servo
sub-assembly.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
AC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
I030157
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
FACE
DEF
I034386E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-2
FACE position
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
3-2
DEF position
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
AC–61
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Resistance (kΩ)
3.4 to 6.2
Arm position
(e) As the mode damper servo sub-assembly moves from
DEF side to FACE side, the resistance decreases
gradually without interruption.
HINT:
For details regarding operation of the servo motor (See
page AC-73).
NG
0.8 to 1.6
DEF
FACE
REPLACE MODE DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
I030161E15
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR OUTLET DAMPER POSITION SENSOR - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the mode damper servo subassembly (air outlet damper position sensor) and the A/C
amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 33 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 33 is output.
A
DTC 33 is not output.
B
B
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
SYSTEM IS OK
AC
AC–62
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
36
Air Mix Damper Position Sensor Circuit (Driver
Side
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the position of the air mix damper and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C
amplifier. The position sensor is built into the damper servo sub-assembly (air mix damper control servo
motor).
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E01
HINT:
This DTC is indicated only for limited grade (right/left independent temperature control system).
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
36
AC
Short to ground or power source circuit in air mix
damper position sensor circuit
•
•
Damper servo sub-assembly (Air mix damper
position sensor)
Harness or connector between damper servo subassembly (air mix damper position sensor) and A/C
amplifier
A/C amplifier
AC–63
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Limited grade:
A/C Amplifier
Center J/B
P
B
3B
1
A27
Damper Servo Sub-assembly
(Air Mix Damper Position Sensor)
B
3B
P
6
Y-G
3
1
A17 S5
A16 SG
2
25
L-O
A16 TPDR
I033597E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TPDR, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Change the set temperature to activate the air mix
damper.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TPDR (+)
I033523E12
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-25 (TPDR) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
MAX. COLD position
3.5 to 4.5 V
A16-25 (TPDR) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON
MAX. HOT position
0.5 to 1.8 V
HINT:
As the set temperature increases, the voltage decreases
gradually without interruption.
OK
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–64
2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the damper servo sub-assembly.
(b) Disconnect the connector from the damper servo subassembly.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
I030157
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
MAX. HOT
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-2
MAX. COLD position
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
3-2
MAX. HOT position
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
MAX. COLD
I033527E01
Resistance (kΩ)
3.4 to 6.2
Arm position
AC
(e) As the damper servo sub-assembly moves from COLD
side to HOT side, the resistance decreases gradually
without interruption.
HINT:
For details regarding operation of the servo motor (See
page AC-76).
NG
0.8 to 1.6
MAX. COOL
MAX. HOT
REPLACE DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
I030161E16
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR MIX DAMPER POSITION SENSOR - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the damper servo sub-assembly (air
mix damper position sensor) and the A/C amplifier (See
page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AC–65
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 36 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 36 is output.
A
DTC 36 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–66
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
Air Mix Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
(Passenger Side)
41
DESCRIPTION
This damper servo sub-assembly (air mix damper control servo motor) is controlled by the A/C amplifier
and moves the air mix damper to the desired position.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
Air mix damper position sensor value does not change
even if A/C amplifier operates air mix servo motor.
41
•
•
Damper servo sub-assembly (Air mix damper
control servo motor)
Harness or connector between A/C amplifier and
damper servo sub-assembly (air mix damper
control servo motor)
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Damper Servo Sub-assembly (Air Mix Damper Control Servo Motor)
5
5
A28 A26
(*1) (*2)
L-Y (*1)
V-R (*2)
24 (*1)
23 (*2)
AMCPA (*1)
A17
AMC (*2)
L-R (*1)
V-W (*2)
16 (*1)
14 (*2)
AMHPA (*1)
A17
AMH (*2)
M
4
4
A28 A26
(*1) (*2)
(*1): Limited
A/C Amplifier
(*2): SR5 Grade
I033600E01
AC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Operate the A/C control panel to enter the actuator
check mode (See page AC-24).
(b) Press the DEF switch to enter the step operation.
(c) Check the air flow temperature by hand.
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
0
COLD side (0 % open)
1
COLD side (0 % open)
2
COLD side (0 % open)
3
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
4
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
5
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
6
HOT side (100 % open)
7
HOT side (100 % open)
8
HOT side (100 % open)
9
HOT side (100 % open)
AC–67
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the damper servo sub-assembly.
I030157
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check
that the lever turns to "COLD" side smoothly.
(c) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 4, then check
that the lever turns to "HOT" side smoothly.
OK:
Motor operates smoothly.
MAX. COLD
MAX. HOT
I033526E02
NG
REPLACE DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the damper servo sub-assembly (air
mix damper control servo motor) and the A/C amplifier
(See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 41 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 41 is output.
A
DTC 41 is not output.
B
AC
AC–68
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
SYSTEM IS OK
AC–10
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
Air conditioning amplifier
A17
A16
I033903E01
AC
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
IG - GND
(A16-1 - A16-5)
Condition
Y-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
10 to 14 V
+B - GND
(A16-2 - A16-5)
W-R - W-B
Always
10 to 14 V
BLW - GND
(A16-3 - A16-5)
LG-B - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Blower motor: Operating
LIN1 (A16-4)
L-B
GND - Body ground
(A16-5 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1.0 Ω
SG - Body ground
(A16-6 - Body ground)
Y-G - Body ground
Always
Below 1.0 Ω
TWI - GND
(A16-7 - A16-5)
L-B - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
SPD - GND
(A16-8 - A16-5)
V-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Turn propeller shaft slowly
TSDR - S5
(A16-12 - A17-1) (*1)
R - P (*1)
Ignition switch: ON, Solar sensor subject to
electric light
4.0 to 5.5 V
TSDR - S5
(A16-12 - A17-1) (*1)
R - P (*1)
Ignition switch: ON, Solar sensor covered by a
cloth
Below 1.0 V
TS - S5
(A16-12 - A17-1) (*2)
V-G - P (*2)
Ignition switch: ON, Solar sensor subject to
electric light
4.0 to 5.5 V
TS - S5
(A16-12 - A17-1) (*2)
V-G - P (*2)
Ignition switch: ON, Solar sensor covered by a
cloth
Below 1.0 V
TR - SG
(A16-15 - A16-6)
V-Y - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON, Room temp.: 25°C (77°F)
1.35 to 1.75 V
TR - SG
(A16-15 - A16-6)
V-Y - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON, Room temp.: 40°C (104°F)
0.85 to 1.25 V
TPI - SG
(A16-16 - A16-6)
P-B - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set air intake: RECIRCULATION
3.5 to 4.5 V
TPI - SG
(A16-16 - A16-6)
P-B - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set air intake: FRESH
0.5 to 1.8 V
TPO - SG
(A16-17 - A16-6)
LG-R - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON, Set air flow: FACE
3.5 to 4.5 V
TPO - SG
(A16-17 - A16-6)
LG-R - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON, Set air flow: DEF
0.5 to 1.8 V
ACT - GND
(A16-18 - A16-5)
BR-W - W-B
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Engaged
10 to 14 V
ACT - GND
(A16-18 - A16-5)
BR-W - W-B
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Not engaged
Below 1.0 V
LOCK - GND
(A16-19 - A16-5)
W-G - W-B
Heater control panel communication circuit
Engine running: Idle speed
A/C system: Operate speed
Specification
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
-
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
0 - 4.5 to 5.5 V
(Voltage is generated
intermittently)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
AC–11
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
HR - GND
(A16-21 - A16-5)
Condition
Specification
L - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Blower switch: ON
Below 1.0 V
HR - GND
(A16-21 - A16-5)
L - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Blower switch: OFF
10 to 14 V
TAM - SG
(A16-22 - A16-6)
GR - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON, Ambient temp.: 25°C (77°F)
1.35 to 1.75 V
TAM - SG
(A16-22 - A16-6)
GR - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON,
Ambient temp.: 40°C (104°F)
0.85 to 1.25 V
TPPA - SG
(A16-23 - A16-6) (*1)
L-W - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set passenger side temp.: Max. COLD
3.5 to 4.5 V
TPPA - SG
(A16-23 - A16-6) (*1)
L-W - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set passenger side temp.: Max. HOT
0.5 to 1.5 V
TE - SG
(A16-24 - A16-6)
G - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Evaporator temp.: 0°C (32°F)
2.0 to 2.4 V
TE - SG
(A16-24 - A16-6)
G - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Evaporator temp.: 15°C (59°F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
TPDR - SG
(A16-25 - A16-6) (*1)
L-O - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. COLD
3.5 to 4.5 V
TPDR - SG
(A16-25 - A16-6) (*1)
L-O - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. HOT
0.5 to 1.5 V
TP - SG
(A16-25 - A16-6) (*2)
L-O - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. COLD
3.5 to 4.5 V
TP - SG
(A16-25 - A16-6) (*2)
L-O - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. HOT
0.5 to 1.5 V
TSPA - S5
(A16-26 - A17-1) (*1)
B-O - P
Ignition switch: ON, Solar sensor subject to
electric light
4.0 to 5.5 V
TSPA - S5
(A16-26 - A17-1) (*1)
B-O - P
Ignition switch: ON, Solar sensor covered by a
cloth
Below 1.0 V
S5 - SG
A17-1 - A16-6)
P - Y-G
Ignition switch: ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
AOF - GND
(A17-3 - A16-5)
LG-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Set air flow: FACE
10 to 14 V
AOF - GND
(A17-3 - A16-5)
LG-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Set air flow: Except FACE
AOD - GND
A17-4 - A16-5)
LG - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Set air flow: DEF
AOD - GND
A17-4 - A16-5)
LG - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Set air flow: Except DEF
AIR - GND
(A17-5 - A16-5)
P-L - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set air intake: RECIRCULATION
AIR - GND
(A17-5 - A16-5)
P-L - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Set air intake: FRESH
Below 1.0 V
AIF - GND
(A17-6 - A16-5)
P-G - W-B
Ignition switch: ON, Set air intake: FRESH
10 to 14 V
AIF - GND
(A17-6 - A16-5)
P-G - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set air intake: RECIRCULATION
Below 1.0 V
AC1 - GND
(A17-7 - A16-5)
GR-G - W-B
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Engaged
Below 1.0 V
AC1 - GND
(A17-7 - A16-5)
GR-G - W-B
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Not engaged
10 to 14 V
PSW - GND
(A17-9 - A16-5)
LG-R - W-B
Start engine Operate A/C system
Refrigerant pressure: Abnormal pressure (More
than 3,140 kPa and less than 196 kPa)
PSW - GND
(A17-9 - A16-5)
LG-R - W-B
Start engine Operate A/C system
Refrigerant pressure: Normal pressure (Less
than 3,140 kPa and less than 196 kPa)
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
AC
AC–12
Symbols (Terminals No.)
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Wiring Color
Condition
MGC - GND
(A17-10 - A16-5)
BR-Y - W-B
Engine running: Idle speed
A/C system: Operate
Magnetic clutch: Not engaged
MGC - GND
(A17-10 - A16-5)
BR-Y - W-B
Engine running: Idle speed
A/C system: Operate
Magnetic clutch: Engaged
AMHDR - GND
(A17-14 - A16-5) (*1)
V-W - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. HOT
AMHDR - GND
(A17-14 - A16-5) (*1)
V-W - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. COLD
AMH - GND
(A17-14 - A16-5) (*2)
V-W - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. HOT
AMH - GND
(A17-14 - A16-5) (*2)
V-W - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. COLD
AMHPA - GND
(A17-16 - A16-5) (*1)
L-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set passenger temp.: Max. HOT
AMHPA - GND
(A17-16 - A16-5) (*1)
L-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set passenger side temp.: Max. COLD
DMOT (A17-19)
BR-B
DMIN (A17-20)
W-L
Specification
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
Multiplex communication circuit
-
Multiplex communication circuit
-
AMCDR - GND
(A17-23 - A16-5) (*1)
V-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. COLD
AMCDR - GND
(A17-23 - A16-5) (*1)
V-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. HOT
AMC - GND
(A17-23 - A16-5) (*2)
V-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. COLD
AMC - GND
(A17-23 - A16-5) (*2)
V-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set (driver side *1) temp.: Max. HOT
AMCPA - GND
(A17-24 - A16-5) (*1)
L-Y - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set passenger temp.: Max. COLD
AMCPA - GND
(A17-24 - A16-5) (*1)
L-Y - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
Set passenger side temp.: Max. HOT
AC
2.
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
Below 1.0 V
(*1): Limited grade
(*2): SR-5 grade
Air conditioning control assembly:
D3
I033905E01
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
B - GND
(D3-1 - D3-7)
R - W-B
IG+ - GND
(D3 -2 - D3-7)
Condition
Specification
Always
10 to 14 V
Y-R - W-B
Ignition switch: ON
10 to 14 V
IG+ - GND
(D3 -2 - D3-7)
Y-R - W-B
Ignition switch: Except ON
ACC - GND
(D3-8 - D3-7)
GR - W-B
Ignition switch: ACC
Below 1.0 V
10 to 14 V
AC–13
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
ACC - GND
(D3-8 - D3-7)
GR - W-B
GND - Body ground
(D3-7 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
LIN-B (D3-14)
L-B
Condition
Ignition switch: Except ACC
Below 1.0 V
Always
Below 1.0 V
A/C amplifier communication circuit
3.
E4
Specification
E5
-
ECM
E6
E7
E8
I030693E19
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
E1 - Body ground
(E6-1 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground (*3)
BR - Body ground (*4)
THWO - Body ground
(E7-14 - Body ground)
L-B - Body ground
ACT - Body ground
(E7-25 - Body ground)
BR-W - Body ground
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Engaged
10 to 14 V
ACT - Body ground
(E7-25 - Body ground)
BR-W - Body ground
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Not engaged
Below 1.0 V
AC1 - Body ground
(E7-24 - Body ground)
GR-G - Body ground
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Engaged
10 to 14 V
AC1 - Body ground
(E7-24 - Body ground)
GR-G - Body ground
Start engine Blower speed: LO
Magnetic clutch: Not engaged
Below 1.0 V
Always
Specification
Below 1.0 V
Engine running: Idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
(*3): 2UZ-FE
(*4): 1GR-FE
2
V/Division
500 msec./Division
(a) Oscilloscope waveform 1:
Terminal to be measured: BLW of A/C amplifier
Setting for measurement: 2 V/DIV, 500 msec./DIV
Condition: Ignition switch ON
I031456E21
5 V/Division
GND
0.1 sec./Division
I031455E03
(b) Oscilloscope waveform 2:
Terminal to be measured: TWI of A/C amplifier and
TWHO of ECM
Setting for measurement: 5 V/DIV, 0.1 sec./DIV
Condition: Ignition switch ON
AC
AC–14
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c) Oscilloscope waveform 3:
Terminal to be measured: MGC of A/C amplifier and
ECM
Setting for measurement: 200 mV/DIV, 10 msec./
DIV
Condition: Ignition switch ON
200 mV
/Division
GND
10 msec./Division
CG
SG
I031459E09
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CANH
1.
SIL
CANL
BAT
E106867E04
AC
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle's ECM uses the ISO 15765-4 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement
of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches
the ISO 1576-4 format.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester to the
DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to
use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a
problem either with the vehicle or with the tester.
If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of
the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem may be
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction manual.
Symbol (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
3 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
3 MΩ or higher
AC–69
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
42
Air Inlet Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The blower damper servo sub-assembly (air inlet damper control servo motor) is controlled by the A/C
amplifier and moves the air inlet damper to the desired position.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
Air inlet damper position sensor value does not change
even if A/C amplifier operates air inlet control servo
motor.
42
•
•
Blower damper servo sub-assembly (Air inlet
damper control servo motor)
Harness or connector between blower damper
servo sub-assembly (air inlet damper control servo
motor) and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
5
A17 AIR
P-L
4
A25 Blower Damper Servo Sub-assembly
(Air Inlet Damper Control Servo Motor)
M
6
P-G
A17 AIF
5
I033599E01
AC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Remove the glove compartment to see and check the
recirculation damper operation.
(1) Operate the A/C control panel to enter the actuator
check mode (See page AC-24).
(2) Press the DEF switch to enter the step operation.
(3) Press the DEF switch in order, and visually check
the recirculation damper operation.
Display Code
Recirculation damper position
0
RECIRCULATION
1
RECIRCULATION
2
FRESH/RECIRCULATION
3
FRESH/RECIRCULATION
4
FRESH
5
FRESH
6
FRESH
7
FRESH
AC–70
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Display Code
Recirculation damper position
8
FRESH
9
FRESH
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the blower damper servo sub-assembly.
I030157
RECIRCULATION
FRESH
I033528E01
AC
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check
that the lever turns to "RECIRCULATION" side smoothly.
(c) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 4, then check
that the lever turns to "FRESH" side smoothly.
OK:
Motor operates smoothly.
NG
REPLACE BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the blower damper servo subassembly (air inlet damper control servo motor) and the
A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 42 is not output again.
AC–71
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 42 is output.
A
DTC 42 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–72
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
43
Air Outlet Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit turns the servo motor and changes each mode damper position by the signals from the A/C
amplifier. When the AUTO switch is on, the A/C amplifier changes the mode automatically between
(FACE), (BI-LEVEL) and (FOOT) according to the temperature setting.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
Air outlet damper position sensor value does not
change even if A/C amplifier operates air outlet damper
control servo motor.
43
•
•
Mode damper servo sub-assembly (Air outlet
damper control servo motor)
Harness or connector between A/C amplifier and
mode damper servo sub-assembly (air outlet
damper control servo motor)
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
4
A17 AOD
LG
4
A29 Mode Damper Servo Sub-assembly (Air
Outlet Damper Control Servo Motor)
M
3
LG-R
A17 AOF
5
I033599E02
AC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Operate the A/C control panel to enter the actuator
check mode (See page AC-24).
(c) Press the DEF switch to enter the step operation.
(d) Press the DEF switch, and check the air flow by hand.
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
0
FACE
1
FACE
2
B/L
3
B/L
4
FOOT
5
FOOT
6
FOOT
7
FOOT
8
FOOT/DEF
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
9
DEF
OK
AC–73
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the mode damper servo sub-assembly.
I030157
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check
that the lever turns to "DEF" position smoothly.
(c) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 4, then check
that the lever turns to "FACE" position smoothly.
OK:
Motor operates smoothly.
FACE
DEF
I034386E01
NG
REPLACE MODE DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the mode damper servo subassembly (air outlet damper control servo motor) and the
A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 43 is not output again.
AC
AC–74
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 43 is output.
A
DTC 43 is not output.
B
B
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
SYSTEM IS OK
AC–99
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
REFRIGERANT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Sight Glass
I033456E01
Item
INSPECT REFRIGERANT VOLUME
(a) Check the sight glass on the liquid tube subassembly.
Test conditions:
• Engine is running at 1,500 rpm.
• Blower speed control switch is at HI.
• A/C switch is ON.
• Temperature control switch is at MAX. COOL.
• Doors are fully open.
Symptom
Amount of Refrigerant
Corrective Procedures
(1) Check for gas leakage and
repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles
disappear
Bubbles visible
Insufficient*
2
No bubbles visible
Empty, insufficient or too much
Refer to items 3 and 4
Empty or nearly empty
3
No temperature difference
between compressor inlet and
outlet
(1) Check for gas leakage with
gas leak detector and repair if
necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles
disappear
Considerable temperature
difference between compressor
inlet and outlet
Correct or too much
Refer to items 5 and 6
Immediately after A/C is turned
OFF, refrigerant becomes clear
Too much
(1) Drain or discharge refrigerant
(2) Bleed air and supply proper
amount of purified refrigerant
Immediately after A/C is turned
OFF, refrigerant foams and then
becomes clear
Correct
1
4
5
6
-
HINT:
: If the ambient temperature is higher than usual but
cooling is sufficient, bubbles in the sight glass are
permissible.
*
2.
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE WITH
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(a) This method uses a manifold gauge set to locate
problem areas. Read the manifold gauge pressure
when the following conditions are established. Test
conditions:
• Temperature at the air inlet is 30 to 35°C (86 to
95°F).
• Engine is running at 1,500 rpm.
• All doors are fully open.
• Blower speed control switch is at HI.
• Temperature control switch is at MAX. COOL.
• A/C switch is ON.
Gauge readings (Reference)
AC
AC–100
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
Pressure on low-pressure side
MPa (kgf/cm2)
0.5 (5.0)
Blower HI Zone
0.4 (4.0)
1.06 (10.80)
0.3 (3.0)
0.27 (2.75)
0.2 (2.0)
1.2 (12.23)
Blower LO Zone
0.22 (2.24)
0.2 (2.03)
1.25 (12.74)
0.14 (1.42)
0.5 (5.0)
Pressure on highpressure side
1.32 (13.46)
1.0 (10.0)
1.5 (15.0)
2.0 (20.0)
MPa (kgf/cm2)
I030081E04
(1) Normally functioning refrigeration system
Gauge reading
AC
Pressure side
Refrigerant volume
Low
0.15 to 0.25 MPa (1.5 to 2.5 kgf/cm2)
High
1.37 to 1.57 MPa (14 to 16 kgf/cm2)
(2) The A/C system periodically changes between
normal and improper function due to moisture
in the refrigeration system.
E050573E01
I022117
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
During operation, pressure on low
- pressure side cycles between
normal and vacuum
Moisture in refrigeration system
freezes at expansion valve orifice,
causing temporary stop of cycle.
However, when melted, normal
state is restored
- Drier is oversaturated
- Moisture in refrigeration system
freezes at expansion valve orifice
and blocks refrigerant circulation
1. Replace cooler drier
2. Remove moisture from cycle
by repeatedly evacuating air
3. Supply appropriate volume of
new refrigerant
AC–101
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
(3) The A/C system does not function effectively
due to insufficient cooling.
I022118
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure low on both low and
high-pressure sides
- Cooling performance insufficient
Gas leakage from refrigeration
system
- Insufficient refrigerant
- Refrigerant leakage
1. Check for gas leakage and
repair if necessary
2. Supply appropriate volume of
new refrigerant
3. If indicated pressure value is
close to 0 when connected to
gauge, create vacuum after
inspecting and repairing the
location of leakage
(4) The A/C system does not function effectively
due to poor circulation of the refrigerant.
AC
I022119
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure low on both low and
high-pressure sides
- Frost exists on piping from
condenser to A/C unit
Refrigerant flow obstructed by dirt
in condenser
Condenser clogged
Replace condenser
(5) The A/C system does not function intermittently
because the refrigerant does not circulate.
I022120
AC–102
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Vacuum indicated on lowpressure side, and extremely low
pressure indicated on highpressure side
- Frost or condensation seen on
piping on both sides of condenser
or expansion valve
- Refrigerant flow obstructed by
moisture or dirt in refrigeration
system
- Refrigerant flow obstructed by
gas leakage from expansion
valve
Refrigerant does not circulate
1. Check expansion valve
2. Clean expansion valve by
blowing air
3. Replace condenser
4. Evacuate air and charge
appropriate volume of new
refrigerant
5. For gas leakage from
expansion valve, replace
expansion valve
(6) The A/C system does not function effectively
due to overcharged refrigerant or insufficient
cooling of the condenser.
I022121
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
Pressure extremely high on both
low and high-pressure sides
- Excessive refrigerant
- Cooling performance of
condenser insufficient
- Condenser is dirty
- Condenser fan motor is
malfunctioning
- Excessive refrigerant
1. Clean condenser
2. Check condenser fan motor
operation
3. If 1 and 2 are normal, check
the amount of refrigerant and
supply appropriate volume of
refrigerant
(7) The A/C system does not function due to air in
the refrigeration system.
CAUTION:
The low-pressure piping may be very hot
and cause serious burns.
AC
HINT: These gauge indications
occur when the refrigeration
system opens and the refrigerant is charged without vacuum
purging
I022122E03
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure extremely high on both
low and high-pressure sides
- The low-pressure piping is too
hot to touch
Air in refrigeration system
- Air in refrigeration system
- Vacuum purging insufficient
1. Check if compressor oil is dirty
or insufficient
2. Evacuate air and charge new
refrigerant
AC–103
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
(8) The A/C system does not function effectively
due to an expansion valve malfunction.
I022123
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
-Pressure extremely high on both
low and high-pressure sides
-Frost or condensation on piping
on low-pressure side
Problem with expansion valve
- Excessive refrigerant in low
pressure piping
- Expansion valve too wide open
Replace expansion valve
(9) The A/C system does not function due to a
defective compressor.
I022124
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
-Pressure extremely high on both
low and high-pressure sides
-Pressure extremely low on highpressure side
Internal leakage in compressor
- Compression failure
- Leakage from damaged valve or
broken sliding parts
Repair or replace compressor
AC
AC–75
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
46
Air Mix Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
(Driver Side)
DESCRIPTION
The damper servo sub-assembly (air mix damper control servo motor) is controlled by the A/C amplifier
and moves the air mix damper to the desired position.
HINT:
This DTC is displayed for only limited grade (right/left independent temperature control system).
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
Air mix damper position sensor value does not change
even if A/C amplifier operates air mix control
servomotor servo motor.
46
•
•
Damper servo sub-assembly (Air mix damper
control servo motor)
Harness or connector between damper servo subassembly (air mix control servo motor) and A/C
amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Limited grade:
A/C Amplifier
V-R
4
A27 Damper Servo Sub-assembly (Air
Mix Damper Control Servo Motor)
M
V-W
5
23
A17 AMCDR
14
A17 AMHDR
AC
I033599E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Operate the A/C control panel to enter the actuator
check mode (See page AC-24).
(b) Press the DEF switch to enter the step operation.
(c) Check the air flow temperature by hand.
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
0
COLD side (0 % open)
1
COLD side (0 % open)
2
COLD side (0 % open)
3
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
4
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
5
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
6
COLD/HOT (50 % open)
7
HOT side (100 % open)
AC–76
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
8
HOT side (100 % open)
9
HOT side (100 % open)
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the damper servo sub-assembly.
I030157
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check
that the lever turns to "COLD" side smoothly.
(c) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 4, then check
that the lever turns to "HOT" side smoothly.
OK:
Motor operates smoothly.
MAX. HOT
MAX. COLD
I033527E01
AC
NG
REPLACE DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short in the harness and the
connector between the damper servo sub-assembly (air
mix damper control servo motor) and the A/C amplifier
(See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 46 is not output again.
AC–77
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 46 is output.
A
DTC 46 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–78
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This A/C amplifier monitors the vehicle speed through signals sent from the speed sensor. The A/C
amplifier uses these signals to receive the ambient temperature sensor signal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
Combination Meter Assembly
Driver Side J/B
5
C9
V-R
1
1G
Center J/B
11
B
V-R
1K
3D
B
3D
V-R
8
A16
SPD
I033607E01
AC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (SPD)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Shift the shift lever to neutral.
(c) Lift up the vehicle.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
SPD
I033523E13
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(e) Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the A/C
amplifier connector and body ground when the wheel is
turned slowly.
Standard:
Voltage is generated intermittently is as shown in
the illustration.
10 to 14 V
0
AC–79
Turn the wheel
NG
Go to step 2
E116248E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the combination meter assembly and
the A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
AC
AC–80
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Blower Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The blower motor is operated by signals from the A/C amplifier. Blower motor speed signals are
transmitted by changes in the Duty Ratio.
Blower Level
HI
M2
M1
LO
0
89
67 100
30 43
SI Duty (%)
Duty Ratio =
ON
OFF
AC
A
A+B
㨄 100 (%)
A
B
1 Cycle
E107334E02
Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the blower motor ON time (A) to the total of the blower motor ON and OFF
time (A + B). The blower motor controller controls the blower motor speed.
AC–81
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
B3 Blower Motor Control
G-Y
3
+B
SI
2
Center J/B
J24
J/C
4
VM
GND
3
A16 BLW
LG-B
W-B
1
A
W-B
B
3F
B
3F
W-B
A
B2 Blower with Fan Motor Sub-assembly
W-L
1
B-Y
2
M
Engine Room R/B
HEATER No. 2
G-Y
2
2
2
1
A14
IC4
From Heater
Blower Motor
Relay
From Heater
Blower Motor Relay
A
J37
J/C
II
IK
I033605E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Operate the A/C control panel to enter the actuator
check mode (See page AC-24).
(b) Press the blower switch and change it to the step
operation.
(c) Check the air flow temperature by hand.
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
0
0 (No blower)
1
1 (LO)
2
17 (Medium)
3
17 (Medium)
4
17 (Medium)
5
17 (Medium)
6
17 (Medium)
7
17 (Medium)
8
17 (Medium)
9
31 (HI)
OK
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–82
2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT FUSE (HTR NO. 2)
(a) Remove the HTR No. 2 fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Item
Condition
Specified Condition
HTR No. 2 fuse
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE (HTR NO. 2)
HTR No. 2 Fuse
F043247E02
OK
3
INSPECT BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
1
(a) Remove the blower with fan motor sub-assembly.
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 2 and
the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 1.
OK:
Blower motor operates smoothly.
2
NG
AC
REPLACE BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
I031426E01
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY - BLOWER
MOTOR CONTROL)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the blower motor relay and the
blower motor control (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
5
AC–83
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the blower motor control and body
ground (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
6
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (BLW)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Set the blower speed to LO.
BLW
I033523E14
1 V/
Division
(d) Measure the waveform between terminal A16-3 (BLW) of
the A/C amplifier and body ground.
OK:
Waveform appears as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Waveform varies with the blower level.
NG
500 μsec./Division
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
I031456E22
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL - A/C AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the blower motor control and the A/C
amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–84
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Compressor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The A/C amplifier outputs the magnetic clutch ON signal from AC1 terminal to the ECM. When the ECM
receives this signal, it sends a signal from ACT terminal and the A/C amplifier switches the A/C magnetic
clutch relay ON. This turns the A/C magnetic clutch on.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
ECM
25
E7
BR-W
2
IK1
BR-W
18
A16 ACT
24
AC1 E7
GR-G
1
IK1
GR-G
7
A17 AC1
A17
IC4
BR-Y
10
A17 MGC
ACT
Engine Room R/B
MG CLT Relay
Y-R
2
Y-R
2
1
5
2
3
2
2
BR-Y
L-B
C
J1
J/C
D1 IC4
C
L-B
Y-R
AC
E
E
3 IM1
J1
J/C
3
A2
Magnetic Clutch Assembly
(Cooler Compressor Assembly)
L-B
From IG1 Fuse
I045662E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch on.
AC–85
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c) Check the A/C magnetic clutch input signal using DATA
LIST.
ENGINE:
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/C SIG
A/C signal / ON or OFF
A/C switch pushed: ON
A/C switch released: OFF
-
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch on.
(c) Check the A/C magnetic clutch operation permission
signal using DATA LIST.
ENGINE:
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C magnetic clutch / ON or OFF
A/C switch ON: ON
A/C switch OFF: OFF
-
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
3
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch on.
(c) Check the A/C magnetic clutch operation using ACTIVE
TEST.
AIR CONDITIONER:
Item
Test Details /
Display (Range)
Diagnostic Note
A/C MAG CLUTCH
magnetic clutch relay / OFF, ON
Operating sound can be heard
NG
Go to step 5
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/C AMPLIFIER (ACT TERMINAL) - ECM (ACT
TERMINAL))
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the A/C amplifier and the ECM (See
page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AC
AC–86
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
5
INSPECT COOLER RELAY ASSEMBLY (MG CLT RELAY)
2
1
3
5
3
1
2
(a) Remove the cooler relay assembly (MG CLT relay) from
the engine room J/B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-5
Always
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Battery voltage is
applied between
terminals 1 and 2
Below 1 Ω
5
Z018060E01
NG
REPLACE COOLER RELAY ASSEMBLY (MG
CLT RELAY)
OK
6
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector from the cooler compressor
assembly.
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal 3, check
that the following occurs: 1) the magnetic clutch's
operating sound can be heard, and 2) the magnetic
clutch's hub and rotor lock.
AC
NG
REPLACE MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
E005280E17
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/C AMPLIFIER (MGC TERMINAL) - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the A/C amplifier and body ground
(See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AC–87
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/C AMPLIFIER (AC1 TERMINAL) - ECM (AC1
TERMINAL))
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the A/C amplifier and the ECM (See
page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
9
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (AC1)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Start the engine and push AUTO switch.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
AC1
I033523E15
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A17-7 (AC1) - Body
ground
A/C switch: OFF
3.7 to 4.5 V
A17-7 (AC1) - Body
ground
A/C switch: ON
1.3 to 2.6 V
NG
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
OK
REPLACE ECM
AC
AC–88
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Heater Control Panel Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is a power supply for the air conditioning control assembly (heater control panel).
WIRING DIAGRAM
D3
A/C Control Assembly
Driver Side J/B
IG1
2
J7
J/C
8
1C
1J
A
4
2
W-L
AM1
AM1
2
H A
Y-R
A
2
Y-R
IG+
C2
IC4
ALT
1
2
2
2
Short Pin
1
DOME
R
1
2
2
2
2
W
2
1
2
B
Center J/B
R
AC
J25
J/C
Engine Room R/B
2
IG1
A
H
Y-R
Y-R
I18
Ignition SW
L-Y
J20
J/C
J7
J/C
B
D
J8
J/C
D
H
H
R
R
W-B
A
A
3C
B
3F
3C
B
3F
B
3F
R
1
W-B
7
B
GND
W-B
A
A
J37
J/C
J24
J/C
Battery
II
IK
I045744E02
AC–89
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the air conditioning
control panel assembly.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
B
IG+
B052311E03
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
D3-1 (B) - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
D3-2 (IG+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the air conditioning
control panel assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
GND
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
D3-7 (GND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
B052311E02
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–90
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Heater Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The heater relay is switched on by signals from the A/C amplifier. It supplies power to the blower motor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
Driver Side J/B
J1
J/C
Y-R
Y-R
E
E
IG1
20
1E
2
1C
From Ignition
Switch
Engine Room R/B
To Blower
Motor Control
Y-R
R
HTR No. 2
2
2
2
1
Heater Blower Motor Relay
2
1
2
2
5
3
4
B-Y
2
2
A11
IC4
L
To Blower
Motor Control
B-Y
2
21
A16 HR
L
W-B
HTR
2
2
1
B
2
B
J3
J/C
B
W-B
AC
Battery
EB
I045743E01
AC–91
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FUSE (HTR)
(a) Remove the HTR fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Engine Room R/B:
Tester Item
Condition
Specified Condition
HTR fuse
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE (HTR)
HTR Fuse
F043247E03
OK
2
INSPECT HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY
(a) Remove the heater blower motor relay from the engine
room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3-5
Always
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
When battery voltage
applied to terminals 1
and 2
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Always
Below 1 Ω
3-4
When battery voltage
applied to terminals 1
and 2
10 kΩ or higher
E032993
NG
OK
REPLACE HEATER BLOWER MOTOR
RELAY
AC
AC–92
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY - BATTERY)
(a) Remove the heater blower motor relay assembly from
the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Engine Room J/B:
Tester Connection
Condition
1 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
5 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
I033590E01
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Engine Room J/B:
AC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
4 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
I033590E01
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY - AIR
CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the heater blower motor relay and
the A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–93
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–94
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
IG Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The main power source is supplied to the A/C amplifier when the ignition switch ON.
The power source is used for operating the A/C amplifier and servo motor, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
Driver Side J/B
L-Y
IG1
2
1C
J7
J/C
8
1J
Y-R
A
Y-R
A
H
J25
J/C
Y-R
H A
Y-R
A
1
A16 IG
Engine Room R/B
I18
Ignition SW
ALT
AM1
W-L
4 IG1
J20
J/C
2
AM1 2
B
12
2
1
2
2
B
2
Center J/B
W-B
B
3F
B
3F
B
3F
5
A16 GND
W-B
W-B
A
AC
A
J37
J/C
J24
J/C
Battery
II
IK
I045742E02
AC–95
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (IG1)
(a) Remove the IG1 fuse from the driver side J/B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Driver Side J/B:
IG1 Fuse
NG
Tester Item
Condition
Specified Condition
IG1 fuse
Always
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE FUSE (IG1)
F043250E01
OK
2
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (IG+ - GND)
GND
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
IG
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-1 (IG) - A16-5 (GND)
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
I033523E17
NG
Go to step 3
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–96
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the A/C amplifier.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
IG
I033524E04
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-1 (IG) - Body
ground
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
A16-1 (IG) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
GND
AC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-5 (GND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
I033524E02
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AC–97
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Back-up Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The back-up power source circuit for the A/C amplifier is shown below. Power is supplied even when
turning the engine switch off and is used for diagnostic trouble code memory, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
4
1B
A/C Amplifier
Center J/B
Driver Side J/B
4
1L
W-R
B
3E
B
3E
W-R
2
A16 +B
Engine Room R/B
ECU-B
W-R
2
B
2
1
2
Short Pin
1
2
2
W
2
Battery
AC
I033601E01
AC–98
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-B)
(a) Remove the ECU-B fuse from the engine room R/B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Engine Room R/B:
NG
Tester Item
Condition
Specified Condition
ECU-B fuse
Always
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE FUSE (ECU-B)
ECU-B Fuse
F043247E04
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the A/C amplifier.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
AC
+B
I033524E03
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-2 (+B) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–15
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
DTC CHECK (SENSOR CHECK)
(a) Start the engine and warm it up.
(b) Perform the indicator check (See page AC-16).
HINT:
After the indicator check is completed, the system
enters the DTC check mode automatically.
(c) Push the "R/F" switch to perform the actuator check.
(1) SR-5 grade:
SR-5 grade:
I033520E01
Limited grade:
I034050E01
(2) Limited grade:
NOTICE:
• In the sensor check mode, which is
automatically transferred from the
indicator check mode, troubleshooting
may be partially performed. Be sure to
perform the actuator check, and then the
sensor check again.
• If the check is performed in a dark place,
DTC 21, 24 may be displayed.
HINT:
When there are no problems, DTC 00 is output.
(d) If the steps are difficult to read because they change
automatically, push the "FRONT DEF" switch to
display the steps one at a time so that they can be
read easily. The items are displayed step by step
each time the "FRONT DEF" switch is pushed.
I033518E01
DTC
I033518E02
(e) Read the code displayed on the panel. (Trouble
codes are output on the temperature display.)
HINT:
Refer to the DTC chart (Diagnostic Trouble Code
chart) for details of the codes.
• Push the "OFF" switch to finish panel diagnosis.
• Push the "R/F" switch to enter the actuator check
mode.
• This illustration shows the switch design of MZgrade models. This design differs slightly from
that of MS-grade models.
AC
AC–16
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2.
CLEARING DTC
(a) There are two ways to cancel a DTC.
(1) During the sensor check, press the "FRONT
DEF" switch and "REAR DEF" switch at the
same time.
I033518E03
(2) Pull the ECU-B fuse in the engine room J/B for
20 seconds or longer to clear the DTC memory.
Engine Room J/B:
ECU-B Fuse
F043247E01
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–99
LIN Communication Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is a communication line between the air conditioning control assembly (heater control panel)
and the A/C amplifier.
WIRING DIAGRAM
D3
A/C Control Assembly
LIN-B
A/C Amplifier
14
L-B
4
A16 LIN1
AC
H016798E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY - A/C AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the air conditioning control assembly
and A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AC–100
2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the air conditioning control assembly with a
normal one and check that the condition returns to
normal.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
AC
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–104
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
(a) Start up the engine.
(b) Turn the A/C switch on.
(c) Operate the cooler compressor at an engine speed
of approximately 1,000 rpm for 5 to 6 minutes to
circulate the refrigerant and collect the compressor
oil remaining in each component into the cooler
compressor.
(d) Stop the engine.
(e) Using SST, discharge the refrigerant gas.
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070,
07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
2.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT
(a) Perform vacuum purging using a vacuum pump.
(b) Charge refrigerant HFC-134a (R134a).
Standard:
600 +- 30 g (21.16 +- 1.06 oz.)
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070,
07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
Amount to be charged
Charge 100 g (3.53 oz.) Mean value in
proper range
AC
+-30 g (+-1.06 oz.)
Overcharged
Point where
bubbles disappear
High
Pressure
Refrigerant Amount
Sub-cool System
I037365E06
NOTICE:
• Do not operate the cooler compressor before
charging refrigerant as the cooler
compressor will not work properly without
any refrigerant, and will overheat.
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
AC–105
• Approximately 100 g (3.53 oz.) of refrigerant
may need to be charged after bubbles
disappear. The refrigerant amount should be
checked by measuring its quantity, and not
with the sight glass.
Check for Leakage
Gas Leak
Detector
I042222E10
3.
WARM UP ENGINE
(a) Warm up the engine at less than 1,850 rpm for 2
minutes or more after charging the refrigerant.
NOTICE:
Be sure to warm up the compressor when
turning the A/C switch ON after removing and
installing the cooler refrigerant lines (including
the compressor), to prevent damage to the
compressor.
4.
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
(a) After recharging the refrigerant gas, check for
refrigerant gas leakage using a halogen leak
detector.
(b) Perform the operation under the following
conditions:
• Stop the engine.
• Secure good ventilation (the gas leak detector
may react to volatile gases other than refrigerant,
such as evaporated gasoline or exhaust gas).
• Repeat the test 2 or 3 times.
• Make sure that some refrigerant remains in the
refrigeration system. When compressor is off:
approximately 392 to 588 kPa (4 to 6 kgf*cm2 57
to 85 psi)
(c) Using a gas leak detector, check the refrigerant line
for leakage.
(d) If a gas leak is not detected on the drain hose,
remove the blower motor control (blower resistor)
from the cooling unit. Insert the gas leak detector
sensor into the unit and perform the test.
(e) Disconnect the connector and leave the pressure
switch on for approximately 20 minutes. Bring the
gas leak detector close to the pressure switch and
perform the test.
AC
AC–106
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT LINE
REFRIGERANT LINE
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
2UZ-FE:
COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE C
DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
COOLER REFRIGERANT
SUCTION PIPE C
7.8 (80, 69 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
AC
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
7.8 (80, 69 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119699E01
AC–107
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT LINE
1GR-FE:
SUCTION PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
COOLER REFRIGERANT
LIQUID PIPE A
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
AC
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
7.8 (79, 68 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119700E01
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–111
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-103)
2.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION
PIPE C
(a) Install SST on the piping clamp.
HINT:
Make sure the direction of the piping clamp claw
and SST by seeing the illustration shown on the
caution label.
(b) Push down SST and release the clamp lock.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to deform the tube when pushing
SST.
(c) Pull SST slightly and push the release lever, and
then remove the piping clamp with SST.
SST 09870-00015
Pull
Push
SST
Release Lever
I003839E01
Disconnect the tube
using hand
(d) Disconnect the air conditioning tube assembly.
NOTICE:
• Do not use tools like screwdriver to remove
the tube.
• Cap the open fittings immediately to keep
moisture or dirt out of the system.
Screw
Driver
3.
I006919E09
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE
C
HINT:
Disconnection of the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe C is
same as the cooler refrigerant suction pipe C.
SST 09870-00025
4.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE
A(FROM HEATER UNIT)
(a) Using pliers, grip the claws of the clip and slide the
clip and disconnect the heater water outlet hose A
(from the heater unit).
5.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE
A(FROM HEATER UNIT)
6.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly (See page IP-6).
7.
REMOVE ECM
• See page ES-434 for 1GR-FE.
• See page ES-510 for 2UZ-FE.
8.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-148)
I033459
AC
AC–112
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
9.
2 Claws
REMOVE SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT NO. 1
(a) Remove the 2 clips.
(b) Release the 2 claw fittings and remove the side
defroster nozzle duct No. 1.
I033460E01
10. REMOVE SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT NO. 2
(a) Remove the 2 clips.
(b) Release the 2 claw fittings and remove the side
defroster nozzle duct No. 2.
2 Claws
I033461E01
11. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 1
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Release the 2 pin fittings and remove the heater to
register duct No. 1.
2 Pins
I033462E01
AC
12. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 3
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Release the 2 pin fittings and remove the heater to
register duct No. 3.
2 Pins
I033463E01
13. REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO. 1
(a) Release the 6 claw fittings and 3 clamps and
remove the air duct rear No. 2.
6 Claws
3 Clamps
I033465E01
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–113
14. REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO. 2
(a) Release the 6 claw fittings and 3 clamps and
remove the air duct rear No. 1.
6 Claws
3 Clamps
I033464E01
15. DISCONNECT CONSOLE BOX DUCT NO. 1
(a) Remove the clip and disconnect the console box
duct No. 1.
I033466
16. REMOVE AIR DUCT NO. 1
(a) Release the 3 claw fittings and remove the air duct
No. 1.
3 Claws
I033477E01
17. REMOVE AIR DUCT NO. 2
(a) Release the 3 claw fittings and remove the air duct
No. 2.
3 Claws
I033478E01
18. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE MOUNTING
BRACKET NO. 1
(a) Remove the bolt, nut and instrument panel brace
mounting bracket No. 1.
I033467
AC
AC–114
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
(b) Remove the bolt, nut and instrument panel brace
mounting bracket No. 1.
I033468
19. DISCONNECT STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Release the 3 clamps and disconnect the
connector.
3 Clamps
I033469E01
(b) Remove the 4 nuts and disconnect the steering
column assembly.
20. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and 8 nuts.
I033470
AC
I033471
(b) Release the 27 clamps.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–115
(c) Disconnect the connectors.
27 Clamps
I033472E01
(d) Remove the 5 bolts.
AC
I033473
(e) Remove the 7 bolts and instrument panel
reinforcement.
I033474
AC–116
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
21. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT CENTER
(a) Release the 4 claw fittings and remove the heater to
register duct center.
4 Claws
I033475E01
22. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Release the 4 claw fittings and remove the defroster
nozzle assembly lower.
4 Claws
I033476E01
23. REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING UNIT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 nut and air conditioner unit assembly.
I033479
AC
24. REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and air conditioning radiator
assembly.
I033480
DISASSEMBLY
1.
I033484
REMOVE MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws and mode damper servo subassembly.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–117
2.
REMOVE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(INDEPENDENCE TEMPERATURE CONTROL)
(a) Remove the 3 screws and damper servo subassembly.
3.
REMOVE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws and damper servo subassembly.
4.
REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw, clamp and heater radiator unit
sub-assembly.
5.
REMOVE COOLER UNIT DRAIN HOSE NO. 1
6.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Release the claw fitting and remove the cover.
I033486
I033485
I034326
Claw
I033481E01
(c) Using a hexagon wrench 4.0 mm (0.15 in.), remove
the 2 hexagon bolts and air conditioning tube
assembly.
(d) Remove the 2 O-rings from the air conditioning tube
assembly.
I034327
AC
AC–118
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
7.
REMOVE COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
(a) Remove the cooler expansion valve from the cooler
evaporator sub-assembly No.1.
8.
REMOVE COOLING UNIT PACKING NO. 1
(a) Remove the cooling unit packing No. 1.
9.
REMOVE COOLER EVAPORATOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
(a) Remove the 4 screws and air duct sub-assembly.
I034328
I034368
I034329
AC
(b) Remove the 8 screws and separate the heater case.
(c) Remove the cooler evaporator sub-assembly No. 1.
I033488
(d) Remove the 2 O-rings from the cooler evaporator
sub-assembly No. 1.
I033489
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–119
10. REMOVE COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1
(a) Remove the cooler thermistor No. 1 from the cooler
evaporator sub-assembly No. 1.
11. REMOVE COVER PLATE
C119714
AC
AC–120
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL COVER PLATE
2.
INSTALL COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1
(a) Install the cooler thermistor No. 1 to the evaporator
as shown in the illustration.
(b) Check that the thermistor sticks to the evaporator
surface as shown in the illustration (A: Thermistor,
B: Evaporator).
NOTICE:
If reusing the evaporator, DO NOT insert the
thermistor to the position that it had been
inserted before. Insert it to between the position
C shown in the illustration.
3.
INSTALL COOLER EVAPORATOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
(a) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the 2 new Orings and fitting surface of the cooler expansion
valve.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL8 or equivalent
(b) Install the 2 O-rings on the cooler evaporator subassembly No. 1.
(B)
(C)
(A)
50 (1.97)
74.5 (2.93)
100.5 (3.96)
255.4 (10.06)
mm (in.)
C119715E01
AC
I033489
(c) Install the cooler evaporator sub-assembly No. 1 on
the heater case.
(d) Install the heater case with the 8 screws.
I033488
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–121
(e) Install the air duct sub-assembly with the 4 screws.
I034329
4.
INSTALL COOLING UNIT PACKING NO. 1
(a) Install the cooling unit packing No. 1.
HINT:
Securely attach so that the gap in the cooling unit
packing No. 1 will not be mode.
5.
INSTALL COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
(a) Install the cooler expansion valve from cooler
evaporator sub-assembly No. 1.
6.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the 2 new Orings and fitting surface of the air conditioning tube
assembly.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL8 or equivalent
(b) Install the 2 O-rings on the air conditioning tube
assembly.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench 4.0 mm (0.15 in.), install
the air conditioning tube assembly with the 2
hexagon bolts.
Torque: 3.5 N*m (35 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
I034368
I034328
I034327
AC
AC–122
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING UNIT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air conditioner unit assembly with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connectors.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
(a) Install the instrument panel reinforcement with the 7
bolts.
I033479
I033474
(b) Install the 5 bolts.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Tighten the bolts in the following order shown in
the illustration to install the air conditioner unit
assembly.
AC
(3)
(1)
(2)
(4)
(5)
I033473E01
(c) Install the 27 clamps.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–123
(d) Connect the connectors.
27 Clamps
I033472E01
(e) Install the 6 bolts and 8 nuts.
Torque: 8.3 N*m (85 kgf*cm, 73 in.*lbf)
AC
I033471
3.
I033470
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the steering column assembly with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 in.*lbf)
AC–124
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
(b) Install the 3 clamps and connect the connectors.
4.
INSTALL ECM
• See page ES-434 for 1GR-FE.
• See page ES-510 for 2UZ-FE.
5.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for installation of the instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly (See page IP-12).
6.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE C
(a) Lubricate new O-ring with compressor oil and install
them on the hose.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(b) Install the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe C and piping
clamp.
HINT:
After connection, check the fitting for the claw of the
piping clamp.
7.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION PIPE C
(a) Lubricate a new O-ring with compressor oil and
install it to the pipe.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(b) Install the cooler refrigerant suction pipe C and
piping clamp.
HINT:
After connection, check the fitting for the claw of the
piping clamp.
8.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-103)
9.
WARM UP ENGINE (See page AC-104)
3 Clamps
I033469E01
Connect
Wrong
Gap
I006878E01
AC
10. INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-104)
AC–128
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
3.
INSTALL BLOWER DAMPER SERVO MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
4.
INSTALL AIR FILTER COVER PLATE
5.
INSTALL CLEAN AIR FILTER
6.
INSTALL CLEAN AIR FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BLOWER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the blower assembly with the claw fitting.
(b) Install the bolt, 2 screws and nut.
Torque: Bolt
9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
Nut
5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
I034332E01
(c) Install the 7 clamps and connect the connectors.
AC
7 Clamps
2.
INSTALL AIR DUCT NO. 2
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY NO. 2
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO. 2
5.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2
8.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
9.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
I034331E01
10. INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
11. INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
12. INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
13. INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
AC–132
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Install the compressor and magnetic clutch with the
4 bolts.
Torque: 24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and the fitting surface of the compressor and
magnetic clutch.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(c) Install the O-ring on the suction hose sub-assembly.
I034406
(d) Install the suction hose sub-assembly on the
compressor and the magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
3.
I034405
INSTALL DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and the fitting surface of the compressor and
magnetic clutch.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(c) Install the O-ring on the discharge hose subassembly.
(d) Install the discharge hose sub-assembly on the
compressor and magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
AC
I034404
4.
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
5.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
6.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-103)
7.
WARM UP ENGINE (See page AC-104)
8.
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-104)
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
AC–135
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the compressor and magnetic clutch in a vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the bolt, magnetic clutch hub
and magnetic clutch washer.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
I033497
(c) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring
and magnetic clutch rotor.
(d) Remove the screw and disconnect the connector.
E037091
(e) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring
and magnetic clutch starter.
2.
REMOVE COOLER COMPRESSOR BRACKET
3.
REMOVE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
AC
E050116
INSPECTION
1.
I033499
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH CLEARANCE
(a) Set the dial indicator to the magnetic clutch hub.
(b) Connect the battery positive lead to terminal 1 of the
magnetic clutch connector and the negative lead to
the earth wire. Turn on and off the magnetic clutch
and measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.35 to 0.60 mm (0.013 to 0.023 in.)
If the measured value is out of the standard range,
remove the magnetic clutch hub and adjust it with
the magnetic clutch washers.
NOTICE:
Adjustment shall be performed with 3 or less
magnetic clutch washers.
AC–136
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
2.
INSPECT COMPRESSOR OIL
(a) When replacing the compressor and magnetic
clutch with a new one, after gradually removing the
refrigerant gas from the service valve, drain the
following amount of oil from the new compressor
and magnetic clutch before installation.
Standard:
(Oil capacity inside new compressor and
magnetic clutch: 120 + 15 cc (4.0 + 0.5 fl. oz.)) (Remaining oil amount in the removed
compressor and magnetic clutch) = (Oil
amount to be removed when replacing)
NOTICE:
• When checking the compressor oil level,
observe the precautions on the cooler
removal/installation.
• Because compressor oil remains in the pipes
of the vehicle, if a new compressor and
magnetic clutch is installed without removing
some oil inside, the oil amount becomes
excessive, preventing heat exchange in the
refrigerant cycle and causing refrigerant
failure.
• If the remaining oil in the removed
compressor and magnetic clutch is too small
in volume, check for oil leakage.
• Be sure to use ND-OIL8 for compressor oil.
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Fit the parts shown in the illustration and install the
magnetic clutch starter.
AC
I032460
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring
with the chamfered side facing up.
(c) Install the screw and connect the connector.
I032461
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
AC–137
(d) Using a snap ring expander, install the magnetic
clutch rotor and a new snap ring with the chamfered
side facing up.
(e) Install the magnetic clutch washer and magnetic
clutch hub.
NOTICE:
Do not change the combination of the magnetic
clutch washers used before disassembly.
I031582
(f)
Using SST, install the magnetic clutch hub and
magnetic clutch washer with the bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
Torque: 18 N*m (183 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
I033498
INSTALLATION
I033928
1.
INSTALL COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Install the compressor and magnetic clutch and
stay, compressor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 46 N*m (469 kgf*cm, 34 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the nut.
Torque: 24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(c) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and fitting surface of the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL8 or equivalent
(c) Install the O-ring on the suction hose sub-assembly.
(d) Install the suction hose sub-assembly on the
compressor and magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
3.
I033927
INSTALL DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the new O-ring
and fitting surface of the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL8 or equivalent
(c) Install an O-ring on the discharge hose subassembly.
AC
AC–138
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
(d) Install the discharge hose sub-assembly on the
compressor and magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
I033926
AC
4.
INSPECT V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-6)
5.
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
6.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-103)
7.
WARM UP ENGINE (See page AC-104)
8.
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-104)
AC–140
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-103)
2.
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the cooler
refrigerant discharge hose sub-assembly from the
cooler condenser assembly.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant
discharge hose sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
Seat the opening of the disconnected parts
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matter from entering.
3.
DISCONNECT AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the air conditioning
tube assembly from the cooler condenser assembly.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the air conditioning tube
assembly.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matter from entering.
4.
REMOVE COOLER CONDENSER CUSHION NO. 2
(a) Remove the nut and cooler condenser bracket No.
1.
I033500
I033501
AC
I033507
(b) Remove the 4 bolts, nut and cooler condenser
cushion No. 2.
I033924
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
AC–141
5.
REMOVE COOLER CONDENSER CUSHION NO. 1
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and cooler condenser cushion
No. 1.
6.
REMOVE COOLER CONDENSER CORE
(a) Remove the cooler condenser core.
I033925
I033505E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE COOLER DRYER
(a) Using a hexagon wrench 14 mm (0.55 in.), remove
the cap and filter from the modulator.
14 mm (0.55 in.)
Hexagon Wrench
Modulator
I032993E03
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cap.
I032475
(c) Using needle nose pliers, remove the cooler dryer.
I032994
AC
AC–142
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL COOLER DRYER
(a) Using needle nose pliers, install the cooler dryer.
I032994
(b) Install a new O-ring on the cap.
(c) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the fitting
surfaces of the O-ring and the cap.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
E055408
(d) Using a hexagon wrench 14 mm (0.55 in.), install
the cap to the cooler condenser assembly.
Torque: 2.9 N*m (30 kgf*cm, 25 in.*lbf)
14 mm (0.55 in.)
Hexagon Wrench
Modulator
I032993E03
AC
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL COOLER CONDENSER CUSHION NO. 1
(a) Install the cooler condenser cushion No. 1 with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL COOLER CONDENSER CUSHION NO. 2
(a) Install the cooler condenser cushion No. 2 with the 4
bolts and nut.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
I033925
I033924
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
AC–143
(b) Install the cooler condenser bracket No. 1 with the
nut.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
3.
I033507
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the tube and
connecting part of the cooler condenser assembly.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and fitting surface of the pipe joint.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(c) Install the O-ring on the air conditioning tube
assembly.
(d) Connect the air conditioning tube assembly on the
cooler condenser assembly with the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
4.
I033501
INSTALL DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the tube and
connecting part of the cooler condenser assembly.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and fitting surface of the pipe joint.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(c) Install the O-ring on the discharge hose subassembly.
(d) Connect the discharge hose sub-assembly on the
cooler condenser assembly with the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
I033500
5.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-103)
6.
WARM UP ENGINE (See page AC-104)
7.
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-104)
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC–145
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL COOLER CONTROL SWITCH BULB
(INDEPENDENCE TEMPERATURE CONTROL)
2.
INSTALL COOLER CONTROL SWITCH BULB
(EXCEPT INDEPENDENCE TEMPERATURE
CONTROL)
AC
AC–146
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
1.
AC
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–17
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
1.
LIST OF OPERATION METHODS
(a) By operating each of the A/C control switches as
shown in the diagram below, it is possible to enter
the diagnostic check mode.
AC
AC–18
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AUTO and Recirculation / Fresh
switches are not pressed at the
same time.
Turn the ignition switch ON
while pressing AUTO and
Recirculation / Fresh switches.
Indicator Check
(continuous operation)
OFF
DTC Check
(sensor check)
(continuous operation)
Actuator Check
(continuous operation)
R/F
OFF
AUTO
DEF
DEF
OFF
DTC Check
(sensor check)
(step operation)
R/F
AUTO
AC
R/F
Actuator Check
(step operation)
OFF
AUTO
DEF
DEF
Cancel the check mode and start A/C control.
: Indicates switch operation
R/F: Recirculation / Fresh select switch
DEF: Front defroster switch
E106866E20
2.
INDICATOR CHECK
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–19
(b) Turn the ignition switch on while pressing the A/C
control "AUTO" switch and "R/F" switch
simultaneously.
(1) SR-5 grade:
SR-5 grade:
I033520E01
(2) Limited grade:
Limited grade:
I034050E01
1 Sec.
1 Sec.
ON
OFF
SR-5 grade:
3.
Limited grade:
I033909E01
(c) The indicator check is automatically performed
when panel diagnosis is activated. Check that the
indicators light up and go off at 1 second intervals 4
times in succession.
HINT:
• The sensor check automatically starts when the
indicator check is completed.
• Press the "OFF" switch to cancel the check
mode.
• If a navigation system is installed, the indicator
will blink and the buzzer will sound.
DTC CHECK (SENSOR CHECK)
(a) Start the engine and warm it up.
(b) Perform the indicator check.
HINT:
After the indicator check is completed, the system
enters the DTC check mode automatically.
(c) Push the "R/F" switch to perform the actuator check.
NOTICE:
• In the sensor check mode, which is
automatically transferred from the indicator
check mode, troubleshooting may be partially
performed. Be sure to perform the actuator
check, and then the sensor check again.
• If the check is performed in a dark place, DTC
21, 24 may be displayed.
HINT:
When there are no problems, DTC 00 is output.
AC
AC–20
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
I033518E04
4.
(d) If the steps are difficult to read because they change
automatically, push the "FRONT DEF" switch to
display the steps one at a time so that they can be
read easily. The items are displayed step by step
each time the "FRONT DEF" switch is pushed.
(e) Read the code displayed on the panel.
HINT:
Refer to the DTC chart (Diagnostic Trouble Code
chart) for details of the codes (See page AC-21).
• Push the "OFF" switch to finish panel diagnosis.
• Push the "R/F" switch to enter the actuator check
mode.
ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Start the engine and warm it up.
(b) Perform the indicator check.
(c) Push the "R/F" switch to perform the actuator check.
HINT:
Be sure to perform the actuator check after starting
the engine.
I033520E02
1 Sec.
(d) As the actuator check is repeated from steps 1 to 10
at 1 second intervals, check the temperature and air
flow visually and by hand.
HINT:
• The display blinks at 1 second intervals in the
step operation.
• Push the "OFF" switch to finish panel diagnosis.
• Push the "AUTO" switch to enter the sensor
check mode.
1 Sec.
ON
AC
OFF
Display Code
I033517E01
Conditions
Step No.
Display
Code
Blower Level
Air Flow Vent
Air Inlet Damper
Magnetic clutch
Air Mix Damper
1
0
0
FACE
RECIRCULATION
OFF
"COLD" side
(Fully closed)
2
1
1
FACE
RECIRCULATION
OFF
"COLD" side
(Fully closed)
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–21
Conditions
Step No.
Display
Code
Blower Level
Air Flow Vent
Air Inlet Damper
Magnetic clutch
Air Mix Damper
3
2
17
B/L
FRESH/
RECIRCULATION
ON
"COLD" side
(Fully closed)
4
3
17
B/L
FRESH/
RECIRCULATION
ON
"COLD"/ "HOT"
(50 % open)
5
4
17
FOOT
FRESH
ON
"COLD"/ "HOT"
(50 % open)
6
5
17
FOOT
FRESH
ON
"COLD"/ "HOT"
(50 % open)
7
6
17
FOOT
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
8
7
17
FOOT/ DEF
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
9
8
17
FOOT/ DEF
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
10
9
31
DEF
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
I033518E01
(e) If the steps are difficult to read because they change
automatically, push the "FRONT DEF" switch to
display the steps one at a time so that they can be
read easily. The items are displayed step by step
each time the "FRONT DEF" switch is pushed.
HINT:
• Push the "OFF" switch to finish the panel
diagnosis.
• Push the "AUTO" switch to enter the sensor
check mode.
AC
AC–108
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT NO. 2
DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY LOWER
SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT NO. 1
AC
HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 3
HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT CENTER
HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 1
C119702E01
AC–109
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE
MOUNTING BRACKET NO. 1
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE
MOUNTING BRACKET NO. 1
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR
ASSEMBLY
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
BLOWER
ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
AIR DUCT NO. 2
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
AC
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
AIR DUCT NO. 1
AIR DUCT REAR NO. 1
AIR DUCT REAR NO. 2
CONSOLE BOX DUCT NO. 1
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C119701E01
AC–110
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AIR CONDITIONING TUBE ASSEMBLY
COOLING UNIT PACKING NO. 1
COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
3.5 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
O-RING
O-RING
COOLER EVAPORATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY NO. 1
Except Independence Temperature Control:
COVER PLATE
COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1
DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSEMBLY
AC
Independence Temperature Control:
DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSEMBLY
COOLER UNIT DRAIN
HOSE NO. 1
MODE DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
Compressor oil ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
C119703E01
AC–22
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator, and other item values to be read
without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST
early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester on.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / ENGINE / DATA LIST.
(e) Check the value(s) by referring to the table below.
ENGINE
Item
Measurement Item / (Range)
Display
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/C SIG
A/C signal / ON or OFF
ON: A/C ON
OFF: A/C OFF
-
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C magnetic clutch relay / OFF,
ON
ON: A/C magnetic clutch ON
OFF: A/C magnetic clutch OFF
-
2.
AC
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relays, VSVs, actuators and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed in the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the tester on.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / AIR CONDITIONER / ACTIVE TEST.
(e) Perform the ACTIVE TEST by referring to the table
below.
AIR CONDITIONER
Item
Test Details / Display (Range)
Diagnostic Note
A/C MAG CLUTCH
(Magnetic clutch relay)
Magnetic clutch relay / OFF, ON
-
AC–23
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check
(sensor check), check the circuit listed for that code in the
table below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit).
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Memory *5
See page
11 *1
Room Temperature
Sensor Circuit
1. Cooler thermistor
(Room temp. sensor)
2. A/C amplifier
3. Harness or connector
between cooler thermistor
(room temp. sensor) and
A/C amplifier
Memorized
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-26
12 *2
Ambient Temperature
Sensor Circuit
1. Thermistor assembly
(Ambient temp. sensor)
2. Harness or connector
between thermistor
assembly (ambient temp.
sensor) and A/C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-29
13
Evaporator Temperature
Sensor Circuit
1. Cooler thermistor No. 1
(Evaporator temp. sensor)
2. Harness or connector
between cooler thermistor
No. 1 (evaporator temp.
sensor) and A/C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-32
14
Engine Coolant
Temperature
Communication Circuit
1. Harness or connector
between ECM and A/C
amplifier
2. ECM
3. A/C amplifier
-
AC-35
Solar Sensor Circuit
(Passenger Side)
1. Cooler (solar sensor)
thermistor
2. Harness or connector
between cooler (solar
sensor) thermistor and A/
C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(8.5 min. or more)
(only when circuit is
shorted)
AC-38
Compressor Lock Sensor
Circuit
1. Compressor drive belt
2. Compressor lock
sensor
3. Cooler compressor
assembly
4. Harness or connector
between compressor lock
sensor and A/C amplifier
5. A/C amplifier
-
AC-42
Pressure Switch Circuit
1. Pressure switch
2. A/C amplifier
3. Refrigerant pipe line
4. Harness or connector
between pressure switch
and A/C amplifier
-
AC-44
Solar Sensor Circuit
(Driver Side)
1. Cooler (Solar sensor)
thermistor
2. Harness or connector
between cooler (solar
sensor) thermistor and A/
C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(8.5 min. or more)
(only when circuit is
shorted)
AC-47
21 *3
22 *4
23
24 *3*6
AC
AC–24
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
31
Air Mix Damper Position
Sensor Circuit (Passenger
Side)
1. Damper servo subassembly (Air mix damper
position sensor)
2. A/C amplifier
3. Harness or connector
between damper servo
sub-assembly (air mix
damper position sensor)
and A/C amplifier
Memorized
(1 min. or more)
AC-50
32
Air Inlet Damper Position
Sensor Circuit
1. Blower damper servo
sub-assembly (Air inlet
damper position sensor)
2. A/C amplifier
3. Harness or connector
between blower damper
servo sub-assembly (air
inlet damper position
sensor) and A/C amplifier
Memorized
(1 min. or more)
AC-54
33
Air Outlet Damper Position
Sensor Circuit
1. Mode damper servo
sub-assembly (Air outlet
damper position sensor)
2. A/C amplifier
3. Harness or connector
between mode damper
servo sub-assembly (air
outlet damper position
sensor) and A/C amplifier
Memorized
(1 min. or more)
AC-57
36 *6
Air Mix Damper Position
Sensor Circuit (Driver Side
1. Damper servo subassembly (Air mix damper
position sensor)
2. A/C amplifier
3. Harness or connector
between damper servo
sub-assembly (air mix
damper position sensor)
and A/C amplifier
Memorized
(1 min. or more)
AC-60
41
Air Mix Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit
(Passenger Side)
1. Damper servo subassembly (Air mix damper
control servo motor)
2. Harness or connector
between damper servo
sub-assembly (air mix
damper control servo
motor) and A/C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(15 sec.)
AC-64
42
Air Inlet Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit
1. Blower damper servo
sub-assembly (Air inlet
damper control servo
motor)
2. Harness or connector
between blower damper
servo sub-assembly (Air
inlet damper control servo
motor) and A/C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(15 sec.)
AC-67
43
Air Outlet Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit
1. Mode damper servo
sub-assembly (Air outlet
damper control servo
motor)
2. Harness or connector
between mode damper
servo sub-assembly (air
outlet damper control
servo motor) and A/C
amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memorized
(15 sec.)
AC-70
AC
Memory *5
See page
AC–25
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC No.
46
*6
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Air Mix Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit (Driver
Side)
1. Damper servo subassembly (Air mix damper
control servo motor)
2. Harness or connector
between damper servo
sub-assembly (air mix
damper control servo
motor) and A/C amplifier
3. A/C amplifier
Memory *5
Memorized
(15 sec.)
See page
AC-73
HINT:
• *1: If the room temp. is approx. -18.6°C (-3.7°F) or lower,
trouble code 11 may be output even though the system is
normal.
• *2: If the ambient temp. is approx. -52.9°C (-61.4°F) or
lower, a malfunction code may be output even though the
system is normal.
• *3: If the check is performed in a dark place, DTC 21, 24
(solar sensor circuit) could be displayed.
• *4: Compressor lock (DTC 22) is indicated only for a
existing malfunction.
To confirm DTC 22, perform the following steps.
(1) With the engine ON, enter the DTC check mode.
(2) Press the R/F switch to enter actuator check mode,
and set the operation to Step No. 3.
(3) Press the AUTO switch to return to DTC check mode.
(4) The DTC is displayed after approx. 3 sec.
• *5: The A/C amplifier memorizes the DTC of the respective
malfunction which occurred within the period of the time
indicated in the brackets.
• *6: DTC 24, 36 and 46 are indicated only for limited grade
(right/left independent temperature control system).
AC
AC–124
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
BLOWER UNIT
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
BLOWER ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
BLOWER
DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSEMBLY
AC
AIR REFINER ELEMENT
BLOWER MOTOR
CONTROL
AIR FILTER COVER PLATE
AIR FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C138859E01
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
AC–125
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
2.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
(See page IP-7)
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR (See
page IP-9)
6.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page IP9)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER SUBASSEMBLY NO. 2 (See page IP-9)
8.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-9)
10. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO. 2 (See page IP-9)
11. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY NO. 2 (See page IP-10)
12. REMOVE AIR DUCT NO. 2
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and disconnect the Instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly.
(b) Remove the 3 claw fittings and remove the air duct
No. 2.
3 Claws
I034330E01
13. REMOVE BLOWER ASSEMBLY
(a) Release the 7 clamps and disconnect the
connectors.
7 Clamps
I034331E01
AC
AC–126
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
(b) Remove the bolt and 2 screws and nut.
(c) Release the claw fitting and remove the blower
assembly.
I034332E02
DISASSEMBLY
2 Claws
1.
REMOVE CLEAN AIR FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Release the 2 claw fittings and remove the air filter
sub-assembly.
2.
REMOVE CLEAN AIR FILTER
(a) Remove the air refiner element from the air filter
cover plate.
3.
REMOVE AIR FILTER COVER PLATE
4.
REMOVE BLOWER DAMPER SERVO SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws and blower damper servo
sub-assembly.
5.
REMOVE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
(a) Remove the 2 screws and blower motor control.
I034189E01
I034190
AC
I033494
I033495
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
6.
AC–127
REMOVE BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws and blower with fan motor
sub-assembly.
I033496
AC
AC–26
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
ACTUATOR CHECK
1.
ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Start the engine and warm it up.
(b) Perform the indicator check (See page AC-16).
(c) Push the "R/F" switch to perform the actuator check.
HINT:
Be sure to perform the actuator check after starting
the engine.
I033520E02
1 Sec.
(d) As the actuator check is repeated from steps 1 to 10
at 1 second intervals, check the temperature and air
flow visually and by hand.
HINT:
• The display blinks at 1 second intervals in the
step operation.
• As an example, the illustration shows that display
code 21 is output.
• Push the "OFF" switch to finish panel diagnosis.
• Push the "AUTO" switch to enter the sensor
check mode.
1 Sec.
ON
OFF
Display Code
AC
I033517E01
Conditions
Step No.
Display
Code
Blower Level
Air Flow Vent
Air Inlet Damper
Magnetic clutch
Air Mix Damper
1
0
0
FACE
RECIRCULATION
OFF
"COLD" side
(Fully closed)
2
1
1
FACE
RECIRCULATION
OFF
"COLD" side
(Fully closed)
3
2
17
B/L
FRESH/
RECIRCULATION
ON
"COLD" side
(Fully closed)
4
3
17
B/L
FRESH/
RECIRCULATION
ON
"COLD"/ "HOT"
(50 % open)
5
4
17
FOOT
FRESH
ON
"COLD"/ "HOT"
(50 % open)
6
5
17
FOOT
FRESH
ON
"COLD"/ "HOT"
(50 % open)
7
6
17
FOOT
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–27
Conditions
Step No.
Display
Code
Blower Level
Air Flow Vent
Air Inlet Damper
Magnetic clutch
Air Mix Damper
8
7
17
FOOT/ DEF
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
9
8
17
FOOT/ DEF
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
10
9
31
DEF
FRESH
ON
"HOT" side
(Fully opened)
(e) If the steps are difficult to read because they change
automatically, push the "FRONT DEF" switch to
display the steps one at a time so that they can be
read easily. The items are displayed step by step
each time the "FRONT DEF" switch is pushed.
HINT:
• Push the "OFF" switch to finish panel diagnosis.
• Push the "AUTO" switch to enter the sensor
check mode.
I033518E01
AC
AC–128
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AC
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
SNAP RING
18 (183, 13)
MAGNETIC CLUTCH WASHER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C119706E01
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
AC–129
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-103)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1
3.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
4.
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the discharge hose
sub-assembly from the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the discharge hose subassembly.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matters from entering.
5.
DISCONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the suction hose
sub-assembly from the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the suction hose subassembly.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matters from entering.
6.
REMOVE COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and the compressor and
magnetic clutch.
I034404
I034405
I034406
DISASSEMBLY
1.
I034407
REMOVE MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the compressor and magnetic clutch in a vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the bolt, the magnetic clutch
hub and the magnetic clutch washer.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
AC
AC–130
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
(c) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring
and the magnetic clutch rotor.
(d) Remove the screw and disconnect the connector.
I034346
(e) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring
and the magnetic clutch starter.
2.
REMOVE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
I034347
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH CLEARANCE
(a) Set the dial indicator to the magnetic clutch hub.
(b) Connect the battery positive lead to terminal 1 of
magnetic clutch connector and the negative lead to
the earth wire. Turn on and off the magnetic clutch
and measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.35 to 0.60 mm (0.013 to 0.023 in.)
If the measured value is outside the standard range,
remove the magnetic clutch hub and adjust it with
the magnetic clutch washers.
NOTICE:
Adjustment shall be performed with 3 or less
magnetic clutch washers.
2.
INSPECT COMPRESSOR OIL
(a) When replacing the compressor and magnetic
clutch with a new one, after gradually removing the
refrigerant gas from the service valve, drain the
following amount of oil from the new compressor
and magnetic clutch before installation.
Standard:
(Oil capacity inside new compressor and
magnetic clutch: 120 + 15 cc (4.0 + 0.5 fl. oz.)) (Remaining oil amount in the removed
compressor and magnetic clutch) = (Oil
amount to be removed when replacing)
NOTICE:
• When checking the compressor oil level,
observe the precautions on the cooler
removal/installation.
I034409
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 1GR-FE)
AC–131
• Because compressor oil remains in the pipes
of the vehicle, if a new compressor and
magnetic clutch is installed without removing
some oil inside, the oil amount becomes
excessive, preventing heat exchange in the
refrigerant cycle and causing refrigerant
failure.
• If the remaining oil in the removed
compressor and magnetic clutch is too small
in volume, check for oil leakage.
• Be sure to use ND-OIL8 for compressor oil.
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Fit the parts shown in the illustration and install the
magnetic clutch starter.
E065508
(b) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring
with the chamfered side facing up.
(c) Install the screw and connect the connector.
I032461
(d) Using a snap ring expander, install the magnetic
clutch rotor and a new snap ring with the chamfered
side facing up.
(e) Install the magnetic clutch washer and the magnetic
clutch hub.
NOTICE:
Do not change the combination of the magnetic
clutch washers used before disassembly.
I031582
(f)
I034408
Using SST, install the magnetic clutch hub and
magnetic clutch washer with the bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
Torque: 18 N*m (183 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
AC
AC–28
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
11
Room Temperature Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature inside the cabin and sends appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier.
DTC No.
11
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
•
Open or short in room temperature sensor circuit
•
Cooler thermistor (Room temperature sensor)
Harness or connector between cooler thermistor
(room temperature sensor) and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
A19
Cooler Thermistor
(Room Temp. Sensor)
Y-G
6
A16 SC
V-Y
15
A16 TR
2
1
AC
I045740E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TR, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TR (+)
I033523E01
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-15 (TR) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON at
25°C (77°F)
1.8 to 2.2 V
A16-15 (TR) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON at
40°C (104°F)
1.2 to 1.6 V
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
AC–29
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT COOLER THERMISTOR (ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a) Remove the cooler thermistor (room temp. sensor).
I030111
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Resistance (kΩ)
4.0
3.5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3.0
A19-1 - A19-2
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
A19-1 - A19-2
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
A19-1 - A19-2
20°C (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
2.0
A19-1 - A19-2
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
1.5
A19-1 - A19-2
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
1.0
A19-1 - A19-2
35°C (95°F)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
0.5
A19-1 - A19-2
40°C (104°F)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
A19-1 - A19-2
45°C (113°F)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
A19-1 - A19-2
50°C (122°F)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
A19-1 - A19-2
55°C (131°F)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
A19-1 - A19-2
60°C (140°F)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
2.5
0.0
10
50
20
68
30
40
86
104
Temperature
50 60 (°C)
122 140 (°F)
I041430E08
NOTICE:
• Even slightly touching the sensor may change the
resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of
the sensor.
• When measuring the sensor temperature, it must
be the same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases
(see the graph).
NG
OK
REPLACE COOLER THERMISTOR (ROOM
TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
AC
AC–30
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COOLER THERMISTOR (ROOM TEMPERATURE
SENSOR) - A/C AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the cooler thermistor (room temp.
sensor) and the A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 11 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 11 is output.
A
DTC 11 is not output.
B
B
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
SYSTEM IS OK
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
AC–133
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
MAGNETIC CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AC
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
SNAP RING
18 (183, 13)
MAGNETIC CLUTCH WASHER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C138860E01
AC–134
AIR CONDITIONING – COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (for 2UZ-FE)
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-103)
2.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
3.
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the discharge hose
sub-assembly from the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the discharge hose subassembly.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matter from entering.
4.
DISCONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the cooler
refrigerant suction hose sub-assembly from the
compressor and magnetic clutch.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant
suction hose sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matter from entering.
5.
REMOVE COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the nut.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, stay, compressor and magnetic
clutch.
I033926
I033927
AC
I033928
AC–31
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
12
Ambient Temperature Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature outside the cabin and sends appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
12
Open or short in ambient temperature sensor circuit
Thermistor assembly (Ambient temperature
sensor)
Harness or connector between thermistor assembly
(ambient temperature sensor) and A/C amplifier
A/C amplifier
•
•
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
GR
A1
Thermistor Assembly
(Ambient Temp. Sensor)
A13
IC4
GR
22
A16 TAM
1
2
Y-G
5
IC3
Y-G
6
A16 SG
AC
I045741E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TAM, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TAM (+)
I033523E02
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-22 (TAM) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON at
25°C (77°F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
A16-22 (TAM) - A16-6
(SG)
Ignition switch ON at
40°C (104°F)
0.9 to 1.3 V
AC–32
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT THERMISTOR ASSEMBLY (AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a) Remove the thermistor assembly (ambient temp.
sensor).
I030155
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Resistance (kΩ)
4.0
Tester Connection
3.5
3.0
2.5
AC
Condition
Specified Condition
A1-1 - A1-2
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
20°C (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
2.0
A1-1 - A1-2
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
1.5
A1-1 - A1-2
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
1.0
A1-1 - A1-2
35°C (95°F)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
0.5
A1-1 - A1-2
40°C (104°F)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
0.0
10
50
A1-1 - A1-2
45°C (113°F)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
20
68
30
40
86
104
Temperature
50 60 (°C)
122 140 (°F)
A1-1 - A1-2
50°C (122°F)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
55°C (131°F)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
60°C (140°F)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
I041430E08
NOTICE:
• Even slightly touching the sensor may change the
resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of
the sensor.
• When measuring the sensor temperature, it must
be the same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases
(see the graph).
NG
OK
REPLACE THERMISTOR ASSEMBLY
AC–33
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THERMISTOR ASSEMBLY (AMBIENT TEMP.
SENSOR) - A/C AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in the harness and the
connector between the thermistor assembly (ambient
temp. sensor) and the A/C amplifier (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 12 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 12 is output.
A
DTC 12 is not output.
B
B
SYSTEM IS OK
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–138
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
CONDENSER
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
O-RING
DISCHARGE HOSE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
AIR CONDITIONING TUBE
ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
O-RING
COOLER CONDENSER
CUSHION NO. 1
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
COOLER CONDENSER
CUSHION NO. 1
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
AC
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
COOLER DRYER
COOLER CONDENSER
CUSHION NO. 2
O-RING
COOLER CONDENSER CORE
5.4 (55, 47 in.*lbf)
2.9 (30, 25 in.*lbf)
CAP
COOLER CONDENSER CUSHION NO. 2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Compressor oil ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
C134077E01
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
AC–139
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COOLER CONDENSER ASSEMBLY
(a) If a fin of the cooler condenser assembly is dirty,
clean it with water and dry it with compressor air.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fin of the condenser
assembly.
(b) If a fin of the condenser assembly is bent, make it
straight using a screwdriver or pliers.
2.
INSPECT CONDENSER FOR LEAKAGE OF
REFRIGERANT
(a) Using a halogen leak detector, check pipe joints for
gas leakage.
(b) If gas leakage is detected in a joint, check the
torque of the joint.
AC
AC–34
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
13
Evaporator Temperature Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature inside the cooling unit and sends appropriate signals to the A/C
amplifier.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
•
13
Open or short in evaporator temperature sensor circuit
Cooler thermistor No. 1 ( Evaporator temperature
sensor)
Harness or connector between cooler thermistor
No. 1 (evaporator temperature sensor) and A/C
amplifier
A/C amplifier
•
•
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier
A18
Cooler Thermistor NO. 1
(Evaporator Temp. Sensor)
G
24
A16 TE
Y-G
6
A16 SG
1
2
AC
I045740E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TE, SG)
(a) Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still
connected.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
SG (-)
TE (+)
Tester Connection
(Symbols)
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-24 (TE) - A16-6 (SG)
Ignition switch ON at
0°C (32°F)
2.0 to 2.4 V
A16-24 (TE) - A16-6 (SG)
Ignition switch ON at
15°C (59°F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
I033523E03
AC–35
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1 (EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a) Remove the cooler thermistor No. 1 (evaporator temp.
sensor).
+
E050650E04
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Resistance (kΩ)
10.0
9.0
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
8.0
A18-1 - A18-2
-10°C (14°F)
7.30 to 9.10 kΩ
7.0
A18-1 - A18-2
-5°C (23°F)
5.65 to 6.95 kΩ
6.0
A18-1 - A18-2
0°C (32°F)
4.40 to 5.35 kΩ
5.0
A18-1 - A18-2
5°C (41°F)
3.40 to 4.15 kΩ
4.0
A18-1 - A18-2
10°C (50°F)
2.70 to 3.25 kΩ
3.0
A18-1 - A18-2
15°C (59°F)
2.14 to 2.58 kΩ
A18-1 - A18-2
20°C (68°F)
1.71 to 2.05 kΩ
A18-1 - A18-2
25°C (77°F)
1.38 to 1.64 kΩ
A18-1 - A18-2
30°C (86°F)
1.11 to 1.32 kΩ
2.0
1.0
0.0
-10
14
0
32
Temperature
10
50
20
68
30 (°C)
86 (°F)
I041431E03
NOTICE:
• Even slightly touching the sensor may change the
resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of
the sensor.
• When measuring the sensor temperature, it must
be the same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases
(see the graph).
NG
REPLACE COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1
(EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COOLER THERMISTOR NO. 1 - A/C AMPLIFIER)
(a) Check for open and short in the harness and the
connector between the cooler thermistor No. 1
(evaporator temp. sensor) and the A/C amplifier (See
page IN-38).
AC
AC–36
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Start up the DTC check mode.
(b) Check that DTC 13 is not output again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC 13 is output.
A
DTC 13 is not output.
B
B
A
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
SYSTEM IS OK
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC–143
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
- COOLER CONTROL
SWITCH BULB
C119745E03
AC
AC–144
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
1.
4 Claws
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Release the 4 claw fittings.
(c) Disconnect the connector and remove the air
conditioning control assembly.
I033457E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE COOLER CONTROL SWITCH BULB
(EXCEPT INDEPENDENCE TEMPERATURE
CONTROL)
(a) Remove the 8 cooler control switch bulbs from the
air conditioning control assembly.
2.
REMOVE COOLER CONTROL SWITCH BULB
(INDEPENDENCE TEMPERATURE CONTROL)
(a) Remove the 9 cooler control switch bulbs from the
air conditioning control assembly.
I033458E01
I033448E01
AC
AC–148
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
REMOVAL
I033506
AC
1.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
2.
REMOVE UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
(See page IP-7)
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
6.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(See page AC-144)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER (See page IP-8)
8.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and air conditioning amplifier
assembly.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–149
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
3.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
4.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
5.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
6.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
7.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
8.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–145
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
C119745E04
AC–146
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
G
G
G
C
C
G
G
G
C
C
C
AC
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
B
B
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
B120190E05
AC–147
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
CONSOLE UPPER PANEL
GARNISH NO. 2
B
B
CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CONSOLE PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
B
B
B
B
B
B
CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
AC
B120191E07
RS–14
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY:
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY:
2#55'0)'4
#+4$#)
'
RSCA OFF
INDICATOR
(*1)
1((
10
SRS WARNING LIGHT
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
CURTAIN SHIELD
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (*1)
FRONT
AIRBAG
SENSOR LH
FRONT AIRBAG
SENSOR RH
CURTAIN SHIELD
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (*1)
RS
CURTAIN SHIELD
AIRBAG CUTOFF
SWITCH (*1)
SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING PAD
C
*1: WITH SIDE AND CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
C123756E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–15
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT SIDE
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (*1)
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR RH (*1)
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR RH (*1)
SIDE AIRBAG
SENSOR LH (*1)
RS
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SEAT SIDE
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (*1)
FRONT SEAT INNER
BELT ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY RH
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH (*1)
*1: WITH SIDE AND CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
C
C123757E01
RS–16
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Front Airbag Sensor LH
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly (Front Passenger Side Squib)
Side Airbag Sensor LH (*1)
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly LH (Side Squib LH) (*1)
Side Airbag Sensor RH (*1)
Rear Airbag Sensor LH (*1)
Rear Airbag Sensor RH (*1)
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly RH (Side Squib RH) (*1)
Center
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly LH (Curtain Shield Squib LH) (*1)
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly RH (Curtain Shield Squib RH) (*1)
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly LH (Front Pretensioner Squib LH)
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly RH (Front Pretensioner Squib RH)
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly LH
(Seat Belt Buckle Switch LH)
Air Conditioning Control Assembly (Passenger Airbag ON/OFF
Indicator)
RS
Curtain Shield Airbag Cutoff
Switch (*1)
Combination Meter Assembly (RSCA OFF Indicator)
Combination Meter Assembly (SRS Warning Light)
Occupant Classification ECU
ECM
DLC3
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
C123758E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–17
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
GENERAL
(a) In conjunction with impact absorbing structure for a
frontal collision, the SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System) driver airbag and front passenger airbag
were designed to supplement seat belts in the event
of a frontal collision in order to help reduce shock to
the head, chest and knee of the driver. This system
is a 3-sensor type airbag system to detect the
impact during a frontal collision using the center
airbag sensor assembly and front airbag sensors. It
also operates the airbag system and seat belt
pretensioner.
(b) In order to detect the extent of the collision during
the initial stages of the collision in further detail, the
front airbag sensors have been changed from
mechanical type to electrical type deceleration
sensors. Accordingly, the deployment of the driver
airbag and front passenger airbag is controlled in
two stages according to the severity of the impact.
(c) In conjunction with impact absorbing structure for a
side collision, the front seat airbag and curtain
shield airbag were designed to help reduce shock to
the driver, front passenger, and rear outer
passengers in the event of a side collision or
rollover.
(d) RSCA (Roll Sensing of Curtain Shield Airbags) is
used in order to deploy the curtain shield airbags
and the seat belt pretensioner for the driver and
front passenger, in the event that the vehicle rolls
over.
(e) The curtain shield airbag that helps reduce shock to
the front and rear seat occupants with a single
curtain shield airbag has been adopted. In
conjunction with this system, the side airbag
sensors have been installed at the bottom of the
center pillars and the rear airbag sensors have been
installed at the bottom of the rear pillars
respectively.
(f) In this system, a front side collision is detected by
the side airbag sensors in order to deploy the side
airbags. A rear side collision is detected by the rear
airbag sensors and the center airbag sensor
assembly in order to deploy the side airbags and
curtain shield airbags.
(g) The center airbag sensor assembly sends the
airbag deployment signal to the body ECU via a
discrete line to operate collision door lock release
control.
CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATION
(a) FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) The front airbag sensors are installed on the
right and left radiator supports respectively.
RS
RS–18
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(2) The front airbag sensor consists of the
deceleration sensor.
(3) The deceleration sensor is built into the front
airbag sensor, and the distortion that is created
in the sensor is converted into an electric signal
based on the vehicle deceleration rate during a
frontal collision. Accordingly, the extent of the
initial collision can be detected in detail.
(b) SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) The side airbag sensors are installed on the
bottom of the right and left center pillars
respectively.
(2) The side airbag sensor consists of the
deceleration sensor and ignition control circuit.
(3) The deceleration sensor is built into the side
airbag sensor, and the distortion that is created
in the sensor is converted into an electric signal
based on the vehicle deceleration rate during a
front side collision. Accordingly, the extent of the
initial collision can be detected in detail.
(c) REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) The rear airbag sensors are installed on the right
and left rear pillars respectively.
(2) The rear airbag sensor consists of the
deceleration sensor and ignition control circuit.
(3) The deceleration sensor is built into the rear
airbag sensor, and the distortion that is created
in the sensor is converted into an electric signal
based on the vehicle deceleration rate during a
rear side collision. Accordingly, the extent of the
initial collision can be detected in detail.
(d) CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(1) General
• The center airbag sensor assembly is
installed on the center floor under the console
box.
• The center airbag sensor assembly consists
of the deceleration sensor, safing sensor,
electronic safing sensor, ignition control
circuit and diagnostic circuit.
• The center airbag sensor assembly receives
signals from the deceleration sensor and
safing sensor built into the center airbag
sensor assembly and front airbag sensor.
Then the center airbag sensor assembly
determines whether or not the driver airbag,
front passenger airbag, and front seat belt
pretensioners should be activated, and
diagnoses system malfunctions.
• The center airbag sensor assembly causes
the front seat airbag and the curtain shield
airbag assemblies to deploy when receiving
signals from the side airbag sensor.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
RS–19
• The center airbag sensor assembly receives
signals from the deceleration sensor and the
electronic safing sensor built into the center
airbag sensor assembly and the rear airbag
sensor, and determines whether or not the
side airbag and curtain shield airbag
assemblies should be activated, and
diagnoses system malfunctions.
• The center airbag sensor assembly sends the
airbag deployment signal to the ECM through
BEAN to operate fuel pump control.
• The center airbag sensor assembly sends the
airbag deployment signal to the body ECU
through a discrete line to operate collision
door lock release control.
Deceleration sensor and ignition control circuit
• The deceleration sensor is built into the
center airbag sensor assembly.
• The ignition control circuit performs
calculations based on the signal output from
the deceleration sensors of the center airbag
sensor assembly and front airbag sensor. If
the calculated values are greater than the
specified values, it activates ignition
operation.
Safing sensor
• The safing sensor is built into the center
airbag sensor assembly. During a frontal
collision, the sensor turns on and outputs an
ON signal to the center airbag sensor
assembly if a deceleration rate greater than
the specified value is applied to the safing
sensor.
Electronic safing sensor
• The electronic safing sensor is built into the
center airbag sensor assembly. During a side
collision, the sensor turns on and outputs an
ON signal to the center airbag sensor
assembly if a deceleration rate greater than
the specified value is applied to the electronic
safing sensor.
Backup power source
• The backup power source consists of a
power supply capacitor and a DC-DC
converter. If the power system does not
function during a collision, the power supply
capacitor discharges and supplies electric
power to the system. The DC-DC converter
operates as a boosting transformer when the
battery voltage falls below a predetermined
level.
RS
RS–20
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(6) Diagnostic circuit
• This circuit constantly diagnoses system
malfunctions. When a malfunction is
detected, it lights up the SRS warning light on
the combination meter assembly to inform the
driver.
(7) Memory circuit
• When a malfunction is detected in the
diagnostic circuit, it is coded and stored in the
memory circuit.
(e) SRS WARNING LIGHT
(1) The SRS warning light is located on the
combination meter assembly. It comes on to
inform the driver of system trouble when a
malfunction is detected in self-diagnosis of the
center airbag sensor assembly. Under normal
operating conditions, when the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, it comes on for
approximately 6 seconds and then goes off.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3.
RS–21
DEPLOYMENT CONDITION
When the vehicle collides and the shock is greater than
the specified value, the SRS is activated automatically.
The center airbag sensor assembly includes the safing
sensor and deceleration sensor. The safing sensor was
designed to be turned on at a smaller deceleration rate
than the deceleration sensor.
(a) The center airbag sensor assembly determines
whether or not ignition is necessary based on
signals from the deceleration sensor and the front
airbag sensor (*1). If the safing sensor and
deceleration sensor turn on simultaneously, current
flows to the squibs to deploy the SRS as shown in
the illustration below.
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Steering Pad
Safing Sensor ON
AND
Deceleration Sensor ON
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Steering Pad
Safing Sensor ON
AND
Deceleration Sensor ON
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
AND
Front Airbag Sensor (*1)
C
C109526E12
HINT:
*1: In case of a front collision, the ignition signal
could be output with the deceleration sensor ON
signal even without a signal from the front airbag
sensor.
RS
RS–22
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(b) The center airbag sensor assembly determines
whether or not ignition is necessary based on
signals from the side airbag sensor. If the safing
sensor and side airbag sensor turn on
simultaneously, current flows to the squib to deploy
the SRS as shown in the illustration below.
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Safing Sensor
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
AND
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
Side Airbag Sensor
C
C109527E03
(c) The center airbag sensor assembly determines
whether or not ignition is necessary based on
signals from the rear airbag sensor. If the safing
sensor and rear airbag sensor turn on
simultaneously, current flows to the squib to deploy
the SRS as shown in the illustration below (*1).
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly Deployment
RS
Safing Sensor
OR
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
AND
Rear Airbag Sensor (*1)
C
C109528E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–23
HINT:
*1: If the front seat side airbag assembly deploys,
the curtain shield airbag assembly will also deploy,
regardless of whether the signal is output from the
rear airbag sensor.
(d) The vehicle is equipped with the function to activate
the SRS in case of vehicle rollover. A circuit to
detect vehicle rollover is built into the center airbag
sensor assembly. When the conditions for vehicle
rollover are met, the SRS is activated as shown in
the illustration below.
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Safing Sensor ON
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
AND
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
Rollover Circuit ON
H045342E01
RS
RS–24
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
The intelligent tester can be used in steps 2, 4, 6, 8 and 9.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check for DTC output.
DTC IS OUTPUT: CHECK MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT: Go to step 3
3
WARNING LIGHT CHECK
NEXT
4
CHECK DTC (Present and Past DTCs)
DTC IS OUTPUT (INCLUDING NORMAL
SYSTEM CODE): Go to step 5
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT: PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
RS
5
DTC CHART
NEXT
6
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
7
NEXT
REPAIR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
8
RS–25
CLEAR DTC (Present and Past DTCs)
NEXT
9
CHECK DTC (Present and Past DTCs)
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT: Go to step 10
DTC IS OUTPUT: Go to step 5
10
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–69
B0105/53 Short in Front Passenger Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front
passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0105/53 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the front passenger side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0105/53
•
•
Short circuit between P+ wire harness and P- wire
harness of front passenger side squib
Front passenger side squib malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
A35
Front Passenger Side Squib
1
2
10
A32 P+
11
A32 P-
RS
C128524E22
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
RS–70
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB)
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector "C"
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
B0105/53
TC
C111755E06
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0105/53 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS–71
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector "C"
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-1 (P+) - A35-2 (P-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
A35
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
P+
PC
C114767E16
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Passenger
Center Airbag
Side Squib
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0105/53
TC
C110398E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–72
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0106/54 Open in Front Passenger Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front
passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0106/54 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the front passenger side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0106/54
•
•
Open circuit in P+ wire harness or P- wire harness
of front passenger side squib
Front passenger side squib malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-66.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB)
D C
RS
Front Passenger
Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0106/54
TC
C111756E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS–73
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0106/54 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
2
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-1 (P+) - A35-2 (P-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Connector "C"
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
A35
P+
RS
PC
C114767E16
OK
RS–74
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Passenger
Center Airbag
Side Squib
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0106/54
TC
C110400E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–1
AIRBAG SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
• The vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS). It consists of a driver airbag, front
passenger airbag, side airbag, curtain shield airbag,
and front seat belt pretensioner. Failure to carry out
service operations in the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during
servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident.
Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the SRS, it is
possible that the SRS may fail to operate when
required. Before performing servicing (including
removal or installation of parts, inspection or
replacement), be sure to read the following items
carefully, then follow the correct procedures indicated
in the repair manual.
• Wait at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned to the "LOCK" position and the negative (-)
terminal cable is disconnected from the battery before
starting the operation.
(The SRS is equipped with a backup power source, so
that if work is started within 90 seconds after
disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable of the
battery, the SRS may be deployed).
• Do not expose the steering pad, front passenger
airbag assembly, center airbag sensor assembly, front
airbag sensor, front seat inner belt assembly, seat
position sensor, occupant classification ECU, front
seat side airbag assembly, side airbag sensor, curtain
shield airbag assembly, rear airbag sensor, or front
seat outer belt assembly directly to hot air or flames.
NOTICE:
• Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to
confirm, so DTCs are the most important source of
information when troubleshooting. When
troubleshooting the SRS, always inspect DTCs before
disconnecting the battery.
• Even in the case of a minor collision when the SRS
does not deploy, the steering pad, front passenger
airbag assembly, center airbag sensor assembly, front
airbag sensor, front seat inner belt assembly, seat
position sensor, occupant classification ECU, front
seat side airbag assembly, side airbag sensor, curtain
shield airbag assembly, rear airbag sensor, and front
seat outer belt assembly should be inspected.
• Before repair work, remove the airbag sensor if any
kind of shock is likely to occur to the airbag sensor
during the repair.
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace them with new ones.
RS
RS–2
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
• Never disassemble or repair any of the following parts
in order to reuse them. If any of these parts have been
dropped, or a defect is found (e.g. cracks, dents or any
other defects) in any of the housings, brackets or
connectors, then replace the part with a new one.
(a)Steering Pad
(b)Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(c)Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
(d)Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
(e)Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
(f) Front Airbag Sensor
(g)Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly
(h)Seat Position Sensor
(i) Occupant Classification ECU
(j) Side Airbag Sensor
(k)Rear Airbag Sensor
(l) Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
• Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting the electrical circuits.
• Information labels are attached near the SRS
components. Follow the instructions in the caution.
• After work on the SRS is completed, perform the SRS
warning light check (See page RS-28).
• When the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected
from the battery, the memory will be cleared. Because
of this, be sure to make a record of the contents
memorized in each system before starting work. When
work is finished, adjust each system as it was before.
Never attempt to avoid erasing vehicle system
memories by using a backup power supply from
outside the vehicle.
• If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile
communication system, refer to the precaution in the
INTRODUCTION section.
HINT:
In the airbag system, the center airbag sensor assembly, front
airbag sensors LH and RH, side airbag sensors LH and RH,
rear airbag sensors LH and RH are collectively referred to as
the airbag sensors.
1. HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR AIRBAG SENSORS
(a) Before starting the following operations, wait for at
least 90 seconds after disconnecting the negative () terminal cable from the battery:
(1) Replacement of the airbag sensors
(2) Adjustment of the front/rear doors of a vehicle
equipped with a side airbag and curtain shield
airbag (fitting adjustment).
(b) When connecting or disconnecting the airbag
sensor connectors, ensure that each sensor is
installed in the vehicle.
(c) Do not use the airbag sensors which have been
dropped during the operation or transportation.
(d) Do not disassemble the airbag sensors.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2.
RS–3
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR VEHICLE INVOLVED
IN ACCIDENT
(a) When the airbag has not deployed, confirm the
DTCs by checking the SRS warning light. If there is
any malfunction in the SRS airbag system, perform
troubleshooting.
(b) When any of the airbags have deployed, replace the
airbag sensors and check the installation condition.
RS
RS–4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3.
RS
SRS CONNECTORS
(a) SRS connectors are located as shown in the
following illustration.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
35
15
Occupant Classification ECU
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
RH (Curtain Shield Squib RH) (*1)
33
16
RS–5
36
34
9
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
RH (Front Pretensioner Squib RH)
31
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
10
32
7
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
RH (Side Squib RH) (*1)
29
Side Airbag Sensor RH
8
30
5
13
6
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Front Passenger Side Squib)
21
14
22
3
Curtain Shield Airbag Cutoff
Switch (*1)
25
4
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
26
1
23
3
2
Combination Meter Assembly
24
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Passenger Airbag ON/OFF
Indicator)
27
4
5
28
13
6
Front Airbag Sensor LH
14
Spiral Cable
19
18
7
RS
17
Side Airbag Sensor LH
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
20
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
LH (Side Squib LH) (*1)
29
8
9
30
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
11
*1: with Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
Seat Position Sensor/Front Seat
Inner Belt Assembly LH
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
LH (Front Pretensioner Squib LH)
31
10
32
33
12
34
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
LH (Curtain Shield Squib LH) (*1)
C123754E01
RS–6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
No.
Connector type
(1)
Terminal Twin-Lock Mechanism
Connectors 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 27,
28, 35
(2)
Activation Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 2, 4, 22, 24, 26, 28, 30, 32
(3)
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3, 4
(4)
Half Connection Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 6, 8, 10, 18, 20, 25, 27
(5)
Connector Lock Mechanism
Connectors 23, 29, 31
Spacer
Housing
Female
Male
Z005953E02
RS
Application
(b) All connectors in the SRS, except the seat position
airbag sensor connector, are colored yellow to
distinguish them from other connectors. These
connectors have special functions, and are specially
designed for the SRS. All SRS connectors use
durable gold-plated terminals, and are placed in the
locations shown on the previous page to ensure
high reliability.
(1) Terminal twin-lock mechanism:
All connectors with a terminal twin-lock
mechanism have a two-piece component
consisting of a housing and a spacer. This
design enables the terminal to be locked
securely by two locking devices (the retainer and
the lance) to prevent terminals from coming out.
RS–7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(2) Activation prevention mechanism:
All connectors with an activation prevention
mechanism contain a short spring plate. When
these connectors are disconnected, the short
spring plate creates a short circuit by
automatically connecting the positive (+) and
negative (-) terminals of the squib.
●When Connector is Connected
●When Connector is Disconnected
Short Spring Plate
Short Spring Plate
Housing
Terminal
Housing
Squib
Connectors Short Spring Plate
Contacting Male Terminal
Short Spring Plate ON
Squib
Closed Circuit
H045309E03
RS
RS–8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(3) Electrical connection check mechanism:
This mechanism electrically checks that the
connectors are connected correctly and
completely. The electrical connection check
mechanism is designed so that the
disconnection detection pin connects with the
diagnosis terminals when the connector housing
lock is locked.
Disconnection
Detection Pin
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
H041646E06
٨Half Connection
٨Complete Connection
Terminal for Diagnosis
Terminal for Diagnosis
Disconnection Detection PIN
H001315E02
(4) Half connection prevention mechanism:
If the connector is not completely connected, the
connector is disconnected due to the spring
operation so that no continuity exists.
RS
Locking Part
Stopper
Locking Arm
Spring
Slider
Stopper
Rebounded by Slider (Spring)
H040180E02
RS–9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(5) Connector lock mechanism:
Locking the connector lock button connects the
connector securely.
Lock Button
Claw
Groove
H040181E04
4.
Lock Button
(Yellow part)
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR
STEERING PAD, CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY, AND FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Tape up the screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Release the lock button (yellow part) of the
connector using a screwdriver (Procedure A).
(b) Insert the screwdriver tip between the connector
and the base, and then raise the connector
(Procedure B).
Lock Button
(Yellow part)
Tape
RS
Mark
C
C123672E01
5.
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR STEERING
PAD, CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY, AND
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
RS–10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(b) Push down securely on the lock button (yellow part)
of the connector. (When locking, a click sound can
be heard.)
Lock Button
(Yellow Part)
H043151E08
6.
Slider
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a finger on the slider, slide the slider to
release the lock, and then disconnect the connector.
Slider
RS
Disconnection is completed
H001586E07
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7.
RS–11
CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector as shown in the illustration.
(When locking, make sure that the slider returns to
its original position and a click sound can be heard.)
Slider
Slider
Connection is completed
H043731E05
8.
Slider
HINT:
When connecting, the slider will slide. Be sure not to
touch the slider while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a finger on the slider, slide the slider to
release the lock, and then disconnect the connector.
RS
Slider
Disconnection is completed
H001584E03
RS–12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9.
CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT SEAT
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector as shown in the illustration.
(When locking, make sure that the slider returns to
its original position and a click sound can be heard.)
HINT:
When connecting, the slider will side. Be sure not to
touch the slider while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Slider
Slider
Connection is completed
H043169E02
Outer
RS
H002763E02
10. DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR FRONT
AIRBAG SENSOR, SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR AND
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) While holding both the sides of the outer connector
locking sleeve, slide the outer in the direction shown
by the arrow.
(b) When the connector lock is released, the
connectors are disconnected.
HINT:
Be sure to hold both outer flank sides. Holding the
top and bottom will make disconnection difficult.
Connector lock is released
Disconnection is completed
H002764E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–13
11. CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR FRONT
AIRBAG SENSOR, SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR AND
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Connect the connector as shown in the illustration
(When locking, make sure that the outer returns to
its original position and a click sound can be heard).
HINT:
When connecting, the outer will slide. Be sure not to
hold the outer while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Outer
Outer
Connection is completed
H002768E02
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–75
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side Squib
Circuit
B0107/51
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front
passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0107/51 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the front passenger side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0107/51
•
•
Short circuit in front passenger side squib wire
harness (to ground)
Front passenger side squib malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-66.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–76
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB)
D C
Front Passenger Center Airbag
Side Squib
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
B0107/51
TC
C111757E05
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0107/51 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS–77
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-1 (P+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A35-2 (P-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
Connector "C"
NG
A35
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
P+
PC
C114767E16
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Passenger
Center Airbag
Side Squib
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0107/51
TC
C110402E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–78
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side Squib Circuit
B0108/52
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front
passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0108/52 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the front passenger side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0108/52
•
•
Short circuit in front passenger side squib wire
harness (to B+)
Front passenger side squib malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-66.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB)
D C
Front Passenger
Center Airbag
Side Squib
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
RS–79
B0108/52
TC
C111758E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0108/52 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS
RS–80
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
Connector "C"
A35-1 (P+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A35
A35-2 (P-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
P+
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
PC
C114767E16
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
DC
Front Passenger
Center Airbag
Side Squib
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0108/52
TC
C110404E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–81
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–82
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0110/43 Short in Side Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH).
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0110/43 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0110/43
•
•
Short circuit between SFR+ wire harness and SFRwire harness of side squib RH
Side squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly RH (Side squib
RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
S27
Side Squib RH
1
RS
2
5
A33 SFR+
6
A33 SFR-
C128524E23
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–83
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (SIDE SQUIB RH)
D C
Side Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S27
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0110/43
TC
C110405E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly RH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0110/43 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
Go to step 2
RS
RS–84
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire
A
D C
Side Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S27-1 (SFR+) - S27-2
(SFR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
S27
SFR+
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
1 2
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SFR-
C
C110406E23
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D C Center Airbag
Side Squib RH Sensor Assembly
RS
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0110/43
TC
C110407E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–85
B0111/44 Open in Side Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH).
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0111/44 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0111/44
Open circuit in SFR+ wire harness or SFR- wire
harness of side squib RH
Side squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly RH (Side squib
RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-79.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (SIDE SQUIB RH)
D C
Side Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S27
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0111/44
TC
C110408E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly RH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS
RS–86
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0111/44 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire
A
D C
Side Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S27-1 (SFR+) - S27-2
(SFR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Connector “C”
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
S27
SFR+
1 2
SFR-
C
C110406E23
OK
RS
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D C Center Airbag
Side Squib RH Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0111/44
TC
C110409E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–87
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–88
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0112/41 Short to GND in Side Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH).
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0112/41 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0112/41
•
•
Short circuit in side squib RH wire harness (to
ground)
Side squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly RH (Side squib
RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-79.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (SIDE SQUIB RH)
D C
Side Squib RH
RS
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S27
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0112/41
TC
C110410E06
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly RH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS–89
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0112/41 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire
A
D C
Side Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S27-1 (SFR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S27-2 (SFR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
S27
SFR+
1 2
SFR-
C
C110406E23
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Side Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0112/41
TC
C110411E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
RS
RS–90
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–91
B0113/42 Short to B+ in Side Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0113/42 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B0113/42
•
•
•
Short circuit in side squib RH wire harness (to B+)
Side squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly RH (Side squib
RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-79.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (SIDE SQUIB RH)
D C
Side Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S27
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0113/42
TC
C110412E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly RH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH (side squib RH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS
RS–92
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0113/42 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire
A
D C
Side Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S27
SFR+
1 2
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S27-1 (SFR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S27-2 (SFR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
SFR-
C
C110406E23
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
RS
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D C Center Airbag
Side Squib RH Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0113/42
TC
C110413E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–93
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–94
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0115/47 Short in Side Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly LH (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0115/47 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0115/47
•
•
Short circuit between SFL+ wire harness and SFLwire harness of side squib LH
Side squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly LH (Side squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
S26
Side Squib LH
1
RS
2
12
A30 SFL+
11
A30 SFL-
C128524E24
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–95
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (SIDE SQUIB LH)
D C
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S26
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0115/47
TC
C110414E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly LH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH (side squib LH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0115/47 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
Go to step 2
RS
RS–96
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
A
D C
Side Squib LH
B
Floor Wire No. 2
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S26-1 (SFL+) - S26-2
(SFL-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
S26
SFL+
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
1 2
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SFL-
C
C110415E17
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
RS
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0115/47
TC
C110416E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–97
B0116/48 Open in Side Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side assembly
LH (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0116/48 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0116/48
Open circuit in SFL+ wire harness or SFL- wire
harness of side squib LH
Side squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly LH (Side squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-91.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (SIDE SQUIB LH)
D C
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S26
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0116/48
TC
C110417E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly LH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH (side squib LH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS
RS–98
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0116/48 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
A
D C
Side Squib LH
B
Floor Wire No. 2
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S26-1 (SFL+) - S26-2
(SFL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Connector “C”
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
S26
SFL+
1 2
SFL-
C
C110415E17
OK
RS
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0116/48
TC
C110418E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–99
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–26
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AIRBAG SYSTEM
Symptom
RS
Suspected Area
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position,
the SRS warning light sometimes remains on even
after approximately 6 seconds.
SRS Warning Light Remains ON
The SRS warning light always comes on even when
no DTC is output.
SRS Warning Light Remains ON
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position,
the SRS warning light does not come on.
SRS Warning Light does not Come ON
Although the SRS warning light operates normally, a
DTC or a normal system code is not displayed.
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
Although terminals TC and CG are not connected, a
DTC or normal system code is displayed.
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
See page
RS-275
RS-275
RS-282
RS-284
RS-284
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–27
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
A30
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY (with Side
and Curtain Shield Airbag)
A33
A32
2 1 6 5 4
3 2 1 4 3
B
A
B
A
B
A 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5
4 3
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
C
C111710E08
Terminal No.
Terminal Symbol
Terminal Description
A
-
Half Connection Detection Mechanism
B
-
Half Connection Detection Mechanism
A30-1
CSL-
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
A30-2
LBE-
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly LH (Seat Belt
Buckle Switch LH)
A30-3
LSP-
Seat Position Sensor
A30-4
LSP+
Seat Position Sensor
A30-7
PL-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly LH (Front
Pretensioner Squib LH)
A30-8
PL+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly LH (Front
Pretensioner Squib LH)
A30-9
ICL+
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly LH (Curtain
Shield Squib LH)
A30-10
ICL-
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly LH (Curtain
Shield Squib LH)
A30-11
SFL-
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly (Side Squib
LH)
A30-12
SFL+
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly (Side Squib
LH)
A30-13
ESCL
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
A30-14
VUCL
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
A30-15
CSL+
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
A30-16
VUPL
Side Airbag Sensor LH
A30-17
SSL+
Side Airbag Sensor LH
A30-18
ESL
Side Airbag Sensor LH
A30-19
LBE+
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly LH (Seat Belt
Buckle Switch LH)
A30-20
SSL-
Side Airbag Sensor LH
A32-1
P-AB
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator)
A32-2
PBEW
A32-3
LA
Combination Meter Assembly (SRS Warning
Light)
A32-5
IG2
IGN Fuse
Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
RS
RS–28
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Terminal No.
RS
Terminal Symbol
Terminal Description
Combination Meter Assembly (RSCA OFF
Indicator)
A32-6
RMIL
A32-7
P2-
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-8
P2+
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-9
+SR
Front Airbag Sensor RH
A32-10
P+
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib)
A32-11
P-
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib)
A32-12
SIL
DLC3
A32-13
D-
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
A32-14
D+
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
A32-15
+SL
Front Airbag Sensor LH
A32-16
D2+
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-17
D2-
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-19
TC
DLC3
A32-20
-SR
Front Airbag Sensor RH
A32-21
RMSW
A32-23
GSW2
ECM
A32-25
PAON
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator)
A32-26
-SL
Front Airbag Sensor LH
A32-27
E1
Ground
A32-28
E2
Ground
A33-1
FSR+
Occupant Classification ECU
A33-2
FSR-
Occupant Classification ECU
A33-4
CSR-
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
A33-5
SFR+
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly (Side Squib
RH)
A33-6
SFR-
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly (Side Squib
RH)
A33-7
ICR-
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly RH (Curtain
Shield Squib RH)
A33-8
ICR+
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly RH (Curtain
Shield Squib RH
A33-9
PR+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly RH (Front
Pretensioner Squib RH)
A33-10
PR-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly RH (Front
Pretensioner Squib RH)
A33-13
SSR-
Side Airbag Sensor RH
A33-15
ESR
Side Airbag Sensor RH
A33-16
SSR+
Side Airbag Sensor RH
A33-17
VUPR
Side Airbag Sensor RH
A33-18
CSR+
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
A33-19
VUCR
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
A33-20
ESCR
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
Combination Meter Assembly (RSCA OFF
Indicator)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2.
A31
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY (without Side
and Curtain Shield Airbag)
A32
A34
6 5 4
3 2 1
B
A
6 5 4 3 2 1 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
B
A
RS–29
B
A
6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 12 11 10 9 8 7
C
C111711E05
Terminal No.
Terminal Symbol
Terminal Description
A
-
Half Connection Detection Mechanism
B
-
Half Connection Detection Mechanism
A31-1
PL-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly LH (Front
Pretensioner Squib LH)
A31-2
PL+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly LH (Front
Pretensioner Squib LH)
A31-3
LSP+
Seat Position Sensor
A31-7
LBE-
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly LH (Seat Belt
Buckle Switch LH)
A31-8
LSP-
Seat Position Sensor
A31-11
LBE+
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly LH (Seat Belt
Buckle Switch LH)
A32-1
P-AB
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator)
A32-2
PBEW
A32-3
LA
Combination Meter Assembly (SRS Warning
Light)
A32-5
IG2
IGN Fuse
A32-7
P2-
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-8
P2+
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-9
+SR
Front Airbag Sensor RH
A32-10
P+
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib)
A32-11
P-
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Passenger Side Squib)
A32-12
SIL
DLC3
A32-13
D-
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
A32-14
D+
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
A32-15
+SL
Front Airbag Sensor LH
A32-16
D2+
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-17
D2-
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib 2nd Step)
A32-19
TC
DLC3
A32-20
-SR
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
RS
RS–100
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0117/45 Short to GND in Side Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly LH (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0117/45 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0117/45
Short circuit in side squib LH wire harness (to
ground)
Side squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly LH (Side squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-91.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (SIDE SQUIB LH)
D C
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
RS
Connector “C”
SST
S26
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0117/45
TC
C110419E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly LH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat siassembly
LH (side squib LH) for measurement, as this may
lead to a serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–101
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0117/45 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
A
D C
Side Squib LH
B
Floor Wire No. 2
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S26-1 (SFL+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S26-2 (SFL-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
S26
SFL+
1 2
SFL-
C
C110415E17
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0117/45
TC
C110421E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
RS
RS–102
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–103
B0118/46 Short to B+ in Side Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat side airbag
assembly LH (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0118/46 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
•
•
B0118/46
Short circuit in side squib LH wire harness (to B+)
Side squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat side airbag assembly LH (Side squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-91.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (SIDE SQUIB LH)
D C
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
SST
S26
1 2
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0118/46
TC
C110420E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat side
airbag assembly LH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH (side squib LH) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS
RS–104
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0118/46 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
A
D C
Side Squib LH
B
Floor Wire No. 2
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S26
SFL+
1 2
SFL-
C
C110415E17
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S26-1 (SFL+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S26-2 (SFL-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
OK
RS
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Side Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0118/46
TC
C110422E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the front seat side airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–105
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–287
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR VEHICLE INVOLVED
IN ACCIDENT
(a) Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check if any of the following conditions occur.
• The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
• Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.)
are installed.
• The front passenger seat is removed from the
vehicle.
• The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator ("OFF")
comes on when the front passenger seat is not
occupied.
• The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair
due to an accident or a collision.
NOTICE:
When an accident vehicle is brought into the
workshop for repair, check the flatness of the
body side that is equipped with the passenger
seat. If the flatness is not within +- 3.0 mm (0.118
in.), adjust it to the specified range.
RS
RS–288
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY:
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY:
2#55'0)'4
#+4$#)
'
SRS WARNING LIGHT
1((
10
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
RS
CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
C
C123749E01
RS–106
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0126/27 Seat Belt Buckle Switch LH Circuit Malfunction
DTC
B0127/27 Seat Belt Buckle Switch LH Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The seat belt buckle switch LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
inner belt assembly LH (seat belt buckle switch LH).
DTC B0126/27 or B0127/27 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the seat belt buckle switch LH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0126/27
B0127/27
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the driver side seat belt buckle switch circuit for 2
seconds.
Front seat inner belt assembly LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat inner belt assembly LH (Seat belt buckle
switch LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
B12
Seat Belt Buckle Switch LH
19 11
A30 A31 LBE+
(*1) (*2)
1
RS
Buckle
SW
2
7
A30 A31 LBE(*1) (*2)
3
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H046330E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–107
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
DTC B0126/B0127/27
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0126, B0127 or 27 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0126, B0127 or 27 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
Go to step 2
TC
C110423E15
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat inner
belt assembly LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–108
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (OPEN)
Floor Wire No.2
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “B”
A30 (*1)
Connector “C”
LBELBE+
B12
1 2
3 4
LBE-
LBE+
*1: with Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
LBE+
Service Wire
A31
(*2)
*2: without Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
Service Wire
C
C123781E01
OK
RS
LBE-
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the front seat inner belt assembly LH.
(b) with Side airbag:
Using a service wire, connect A30-19 (LBE+) and A30-2
(LBE-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) without Side airbag:
Using a service wire, connect A31-11 (LBE+) and A31-7
(LBE-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B12-1 (LBE+) - B12-3
(LBE-)
Always
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–109
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO B+)
Floor Wire No.2
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B12-1 (LBE+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
B12-3 (LBE-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Connector “C”
NG
B12
LBE+
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
1 2
3 4
LBEC
C111660E29
OK
5
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO GROUND)
Floor Wire No.2
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
LBEC
1 2
3 4
C111660E29
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B12-1 (LBE+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
B12-3 (LBE-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
B12
LBE+
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
RS
RS–110
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT)
Floor Wire No.2
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B12-1 (LBE+) - B12-3
(LBE-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
Connector “C”
B12
LBE+
LBEC
1 2
3 4
C111660E29
OK
7
CHECK FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
RS
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0126/B0127/27
TC
C110423E15
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat inner belt
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0126, B0127 or 27 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0126, B0127 or 27 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
Go to step 8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
8
RS–111
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat inner belt assembly LH (See page
SB-6).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0126/B0127/27
TC
C110423E15
OK
END
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0126/27 is output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0126/27 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–112
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0130/63 Short in Front Pretensioner Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0130/63 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the front pretensioner squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0130/63
•
•
Trouble Area
•
Short circuit between PR+ wire harness and PRwire harness of front pretensioner squib RH
Front pretensioner squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
P17
Front Pretensioner Squib RH
1
2
RS
5
9
A33 A34 PR+
(*1) (*2)
10 6
A33 A34 PR(*1) (*2)
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H044107E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–113
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH)
D C
Front Pretensioner
Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
P17
SST
DLC3
CG
DTC B0130/63
TC
C
C111724E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0130/63 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) from the floor
wire.
RS
RS–114
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(d) Check that the floor wire connector (on the front seat
outer belt assembly RH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, and the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire
A
D C
B Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
P17
C
RS
PR-
C111725E15
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P17-1 (PR+) - P17-2 (PR)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
PR+
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–115
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D C Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0130/63
TC
C110427E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–116
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0131/64 Open in Front Pretensioner Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0131/64 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the front pretensioner squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0131/64
Open circuit in PR+ wire harness or PR- wire
harness of front pretensioner squib RH
Front pretensioner squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-109.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
RS
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH)
D C Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
Connector “C”
P17
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0131/64
TC
C111726E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS–117
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0131/64 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire
A
B Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
D C
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P17-1 (PR+) - P17-2 (PR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector “C”
P17
PR+
PR-
RS
C
C111725E15
OK
RS–118
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0131/64
TC
C110429E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–119
Short to GND in Front Pretensioner Squib RH
Circuit
B0132/61
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0132/61 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the front pretensioner squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0132/61
•
•
Short circuit in front pretensioner squib RH wire
harness (to ground)
Front pretensioner squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-109.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–120
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH)
D C Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
Connector “C”
P17
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0132/61
TC
C111727E05
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0132/61 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
Go to step 2
RS–121
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire
A
B Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
D C
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P17-1 (PR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
P17-2 (PR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
P17
PR+
C
PR-
C111725E15
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Pretensioner
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0132/61
TC
C110431E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–122
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Short to B+ in Front Pretensioner Squib RH Circuit
B0133/62
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0133/62 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the front pretensioner squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0133/62
•
•
Short circuit in front pretensioner squib RH wire
harness (to B+)
Front pretensioner squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-109.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–123
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH)
D C Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
Connector “C”
P17
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0133/62
TC
C111728E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly RH (front pretensioner squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0133/62 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
Go to step 2
RS
RS–124
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire
A
B Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
D C
Connector “C”
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P17-1 (PR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
P17-2 (PR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
P17
NG
PR+
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
PR-
C111725E15
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
DC Center Airbag
Front Pretensioner Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0133/62
TC
C110433E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–125
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–126
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0135/73 Short in Front Pretensioner Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0135/73 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the front pretensioner squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0135/73
•
•
Short circuit between PL+ wire harness and PLwire harness of front pretensioner squib LH
Front pretensioner squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
P16
Front Pretensioner Squib LH
1
2
RS
2
8
A30 A31 PL+
(*1) (*2)
1
7
A30 A31 PL(*1) (*2)
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H044104E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–127
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH)
D C
Front Pretensioner
Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector "C"
P16
SST
DLC3
CG
DTC B0135/73
TC
C
C109513E11
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0135/73 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) from the floor
wire No. 2.
RS
RS–128
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(d) Check that the floor wire No. 2 connector (on the front
seat outer belt assembly LH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, and the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
OK
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D C
B
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
P16
C
RS
PL-
C111703E19
OK
Condition
Specified condition
P16-1 (PL+) - P16-2 (PL)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
PL+
Tester connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–129
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0135/73
TC
C110436E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0135/73 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–130
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0136/74 Open in Front Pretensioner Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0136/74 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the front pretensioner squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0136/74
Open circuit in PL+ wire harness or PL- wire
harness of front pretensioner squib LH
Front pretensioner squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-123.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH)
D C
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
RS
Connector “C”
P16
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0136/74
TC
C111729E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS–131
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0136/74 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D C
B
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P16-1 (PL+) - P16-2 (PL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
Connector “C”
P16
PL+
PL-
RS
C
C111703E19
OK
RS–132
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0136/74
TC
C110438E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0136/74 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–133
Short to GND in Front Pretensioner Squib LH
Circuit
B0137/71
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0137/71 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the front pretensioner squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0137/71
•
•
Short circuit in front pretensioner squib LH wire
harness (to ground)
Front pretensioner squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-123.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–134
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH)
D C
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
P16
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0137/71
TC
C111730E05
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0135/73 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
Go to step 2
RS–135
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D C
B
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P16-1 (PL+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
P16-2 (PL-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
P16
PL+
C
PL-
C111703E19
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0137/71
TC
C110440E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0137/71 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–30
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Terminal No.
Terminal Symbol
A32-23
GSW2
ECM
Terminal Description
A32-25
PAON
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator)
A32-26
-SL
Front Airbag Sensor LH
A32-27
E1
Ground
A32-28
E2
Ground
A34-3
FSR+
Occupant Classification ECU
A34-5
PR+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly RH (Front
Pretensioner Squib RH)
A34-6
PR-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly RH (Front
Pretensioner Squib RH)
A34-10
FSR-
Occupant Classification ECU
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG SG
1.
SIL
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECU uses ISO 15765-4 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
H100769E98
Symbols (Terminal No.)
RS
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
HINT:
If the display shows a communication error
message when connecting the cable of the
intelligent tester to the DLC3, turning the ignition
switch to the ON position and operating the
intelligent tester, there is a problem on the vehicle
side or tool side.
• If communication is normal when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2.
Vibrate Slightly
Shake Slightly
Vibrate Slightly
3.
D025083E02
RS–31
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no
symptoms occur. In such cases, a thorough customer
problem analysis must be carried out. Then the same or
similar conditions and environment in which the problem
occurred in the customer's vehicle should be simulated.
No matter how experienced or skilled a technician may
be, if he proceeds to troubleshoot without confirming the
problem symptoms, he will likely overlook something
important and make a wrong guess at some points in the
repair operation.
This leads to a standstill in troubleshooting.
(a) Vibration method: When vibration seems to be the
major cause.
HINT:
Perform the simulation method only during the
primary check period (for approximately 6 seconds
after the ignition switch is turned to the ON position).
(1) Slightly vibrate the part of the sensor considered
to be the problem with your fingers and check
whether the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Shaking the relays too strongly may result in
open relays.
(2) Slightly shake the connector vertically and
horizontally.
(3) Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and
horizontally.
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration
are the major areas to be checked thoroughly.
FUNCTION OF SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Primary check.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
After 2 seconds or more, turn the ignition switch
to the ON position. The SRS warning light
comes on for approximately 6 seconds and the
diagnosis of the SRS airbag system (including
the seat belt pretensioner and front passenger
occupant classification system) is performed.
HINT:
If trouble is detected during the primary check,
the SRS warning light remains on even after the
primary check period (for approximately 6
seconds) has elapsed.
(b) Constant check.
(1) After the primary check, the center airbag sensor
assembly constantly monitors the airbag system
for trouble.
HINT:
If trouble is detected during the constant check,
the center airbag sensor assembly functions as
follows:
• The SRS warning light comes on.
RS
RS–32
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
• The SRS warning light goes off, and then
comes on. This blinking pattern indicates a
source voltage drop. The SRS warning light
goes off 10 seconds after the source voltage
returns to normal.
(c) Review.
(1) When the airbag system is normal:
The SRS warning light comes on only for the
primary check period (for approximately 6
seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the
ON position).
(2) When the airbag system has trouble:
• The SRS warning light remains on even after
the primary check period has elapsed.
• The SRS warning light goes off after the
primary check, but comes on again during the
constant check.
• The SRS warning light does not come on
when turning the Ignition switch from the
LOCK to the ON position.
HINT:
The center airbag sensor assembly keeps the
SRS warning light on if the airbag has been
deployed.
4.
RS
C093955E02
5.
Condition
Vacant
SRS WARNING LIGHT CHECK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and
check that the SRS warning light comes on for
approximately 6 seconds (primary check).
(b) Check that the SRS warning light goes off
approximately 6 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position (constant check).
HINT:
When any of the following symptoms occur, refer to
the "Problem Symptoms Table" (See page RS-24).
• The SRS warning light comes on occasionally,
after the primary check period has elapsed.
• The SRS warning light comes on, but a DTC is
not output.
• When the ignition switch is turned to ON position,
the SRS warning light does not come on.
FUNCTION OF PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
INDICATOR
(a) Initial check
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator comes
on for approximately 4 seconds, then goes off
for approximately 2 seconds.
(3) Approximately 6 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position, the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator will be ON/
OFF depending on the conditions listed below.
"ON" indicator
"OFF" indicator
OFF
OFF
RS–33
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Condition
"ON" indicator
"OFF" indicator
ON
OFF
Adult is seated.
Child is seated.
OFF
ON
Child restraint system is set.
OFF
ON
Front passenger occupant classification
failure
OFF
ON
HINT:
• The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator is
based on the timing chart below in order to
check the indicator light circuit.
ON
Ignition Switch
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
(”ON”)
2 sec.
4 sec.
2 sec.
ON
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
(”OFF”)
4 sec.
ON
OFF
ON/OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
H043700E01
• When the front passenger occupant
classification system has trouble, both the
SRS warning light and the passenger airbag
ON/OFF indicator come on. In this case,
check the DTCs in the "AIRBAG SYSTEM"
first. Then troubleshoot the occupant
classification system if DTC B1150/23 is
detected, and troubleshoot the passenger
airbag ON/OFF indicator if DTC B1152/28 is
detected.
6.
H045951
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CHECK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
("ON" and "OFF") comes on for approximately 4
seconds, then goes off for approximately 2 seconds.
HINT:
Refer to the table in the previous step regarding the
passenger airbag ON/ OFF indicator when the
ignition switch is turned to the ON position and
approximately 6 seconds pass.
RS
RS–34
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7.
RS
ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
(a) FUNCTION OF ACTIVATION PREVENTION
MECHANISM
(1) An activation prevention mechanism is built into
the connector (on the center airbag sensor
assembly side) of the airbag system squib circuit
to prevent accidental airbag activation.
(2) This mechanism closes the circuit when the
connector is disconnected by bringing the short
spring into contact with the terminals and
shutting off external electricity to prevent
accidental airbag activation.
(b) RELEASE METHOD OF ACTIVATION
PREVENTION MECHANISM
(1) To release the activation prevention mechanism,
insert a piece of paper with the same thickness
as the male terminal (approximately 0.5 mm
(0.020 in.)) between the terminals and the short
spring to break the connection.
(2) Refer to the illustrations on the next 2 pages for
connectors used in the activation prevention
mechanism and its release method.
CAUTION:
Never release the activation prevention
mechanism on the squib connector even
when inspecting with the squib
disconnected.
NOTICE:
• Do not release the activation prevention
mechanism unless specially directed by
the troubleshooting procedure.
• To prevent the terminal and the short
spring from becoming damaged, always
use a piece of paper with the same
thickness as the male terminal.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
35
15
Occupant Classification ECU
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
RH (Curtain Shield Squib RH) (*1)
33
16
RS–35
36
34
9
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
RH (Front Pretensioner Squib RH)
31
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
10
32
7
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
RH (Side Squib RH) (*1)
29
Side Airbag Sensor RH
8
30
5
13
6
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
(Front Passenger Side Squib)
21
14
22
3
Curtain Shield Airbag Cutoff
Switch (*1)
25
4
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
26
1
23
3
2
Combination Meter Assembly
24
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Passenger Airbag ON/OFF
Indicator)
27
4
5
28
13
6
Front Airbag Sensor LH
14
Spiral Cable
19
18
7
RS
17
Side Airbag Sensor LH
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
20
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
LH (Side Squib LH) (*1)
29
8
9
30
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
11
*1: with Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
Seat Position Sensor/Front Seat
Inner Belt Assembly LH
Front Seat Outer Belt Assembly
LH (Front Pretensioner Squib LH)
31
10
32
33
12
34
Curtain Shield Airbag Assembly
LH (Curtain Shield Squib LH) (*1)
C123754E01
RS–36
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
4
2
After Release
Before Release
4
Paper
Paper
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
4
2
After Release
Before Release
4
Paper
Paper
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Connector 18
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
Paper
Paper
RS
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Connector 30
Short Spring
Short Spring
Paper
Paper
Short Spring
C111742E05
RS–136
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Short to B+ in Front Pretensioner Squib LH Circuit
B0138/72
DESCRIPTION
The front pretensioner squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the front seat
outer belt assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0138/72 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the front pretensioner squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0138/72
•
•
Short circuit in front pretensioner squib LH wire
harness (to B+)
Front pretensioner squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat outer belt assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-123.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–137
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH)
D C
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
P16
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0138/72
TC
C111731E05
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH (front pretensioner squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0138/72 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
Go to step 2
RS
RS–138
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D C
B
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
P16
PL+
C
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P16-1 (PL+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
P16-2 (PL-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
PL-
C111703E19
OK
3
RS
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Pretensioner
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B0138/72
TC
C110442E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the front seat outer belt
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0138/72 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–139
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–140
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1100/31 Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor assembly circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, safing sensor,
drive circuit, diagnosis circuit and ignition control, etc.
It receives signals from the airbag sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated, and detects
diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1100/31 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the center airbag sensor assembly circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
B1100/31
Short in front airbag sensor RH circuit (to ground)
Short in front airbag sensor RH circuit (to B+)
Short in front airbag sensor RH circuit
Short in front airbag sensor LH circuit (to ground)
Short in front airbag sensor LH circuit (to B+)
Short in front airbag sensor LH circuit
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Center airbag sensor assembly
Engine room main wire
Instrument panel wire
HINT:
When a trouble code is displayed simultaneously with B1100/31, repair the malfunction indicated by this
code (except B1100/31) first.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A15
Front Airbag Sensor RH
+SR
-SR
RS
2
1
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
2
IN2
1
IN2
9
A32 +SR
20
A32 -SR
A14
Front Airbag Sensor LH
+SL
2
-SL
C
1
2
IC1
1
IC1
15
A32 +SL
26
A32 -SL
C111743E09
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–141
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (SHORT TO GROUND)
F
A
E
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
A15
-SR
+SR
C
C123608E35
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front airbag sensor
RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A15-1 (-SR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (SHORT TO B+)
F
A
E
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
DC
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A15-1 (-SR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A15
-SR
C
NG
+SR
C123608E35
OK
Go to step 9
RS
RS–142
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (SHORT)
F
A
E
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - A15-1 (SR)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
A15
-SR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Go to step 10
+SR
C
C123608E35
OK
4
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (SHORT TO GROUND)
F
A
E
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
RS
(a) Disconnect the connector from the front airbag sensor
LH.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
DC
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
A14
-SL
C
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A14-1 (-SL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
+SL
C123608E36
OK
Tester connection
Go to step 11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–143
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (SHORT TO B+)
F
A
E
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 V
A14-1 (-SL) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 V
A14
-SL
NG
+SL
C
Go to step 12
C123608E36
OK
6
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (SHORT)
F
A
E
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
DC
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
C
+SL
C123608E36
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - A14-1 (SL)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
A14
-SL
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
RS
Go to step 13
RS–144
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DTC B1100/31
DLC3
CG TC
H041086E06
(a) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor
assembly, front airbag sensors RH and LH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1100/31 is not output.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
8
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
A
F
E
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Engine Room Main Wire
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A15-1 (-SR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “E”
A15
-SR
C
+SR
C123609E26
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9
RS–145
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F
E
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Engine Room Main Wire
Connector “E”
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A15-1 (-SR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A15
-SR
C
NG
+SR
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
C123609E26
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
RS
RS–146
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F
E
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - A15-1 (SR)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Engine Room Main Wire
Connector “E”
A15
-SR
C
+SR
C123609E26
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
RS
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
11
RS–147
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F
E
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Engine Room Main Wire
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A14-1 (-SL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
Connector “E”
A14
-SL
C
+SL
C123609E27
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
RS
RS–148
12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F
E
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Engine Room Main Wire
Connector “E”
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A14-1 (-SL) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A14
-SL
C
NG
+SL
C123609E27
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
RS
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
13
RS–149
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F
E
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - A14-1 (SL)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Engine Room Main Wire
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
Connector “E”
A14
-SL
C
+SL
C123609E27
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
RS
RS–386
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
STEERING PAD
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
“TORX” SCREW
“TORX” SCREW
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
STEERING COLUMN
COVER UPPER
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
SPIRAL CABLE
RS
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2
STEERING COLUMN
COVER LOWER
STEERING PAD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C
C131315E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
RS–387
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT STEERING PAD (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED
IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the steering pad installed on the vehicle,
perform a visual check. If there are any defects as
mentioned below, replace the steering pad with a
new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
steering pad top surface or in the grooved portion.
2.
H042163
INSPECT STEERING PAD (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN
COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28 ).
(b) With the steering pad removed from the vehicle,
perform a visual check. If there are any defects as
mentioned below, replace the steering pad or
steering wheel assembly with a new one:
• Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on
the steering pad top surface or in the grooved
portion.
• Cracks or other damage to the connectors.
• Deformation of the steering wheel assembly.
• Deformation of the horn button contact plate of
the steering pad.
• There should be no interference between the
steering pad and steering wheel assembly, and
the clearance should be uniform all the way
around when the new steering pad is installed on
the steering wheel assembly.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
Horn Button
Contact Plate
C123766E01
RS
RS–150
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
Half Connection in Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly Connectors
B1135/24
DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor assembly connector has a mechanism that electrically detects half connection.
The center airbag sensor assembly monitors the voltage applied to the disconnection detection pins and
detects half connection.
DTC B1135/24 is recorded when the center airbag sensor assembly detects an open circuit in the
electrical connection check mechanism of the airbag sensor connector or in the airbag sensor circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1135/24
•
Malfunction of electrical connection check
mechanism of center airbag sensor assembly
connector
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
Electrical connection check mechanism
Center airbag sensor assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check the connection of the center airbag sensor
assembly connectors.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
HINT:
When the connectors are not firmly connected,
disconnect them once and reconnect them securely.
NEXT
RS
2
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1135/24
TC
C110445E01
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1135/24 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1135/24 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–151
OK
END
3
PERFORM VISUAL CHECK OF DISCONNECTION DETECTION PIN
without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Disconnection Detection Pin
with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(d) Check the disconnection detection pin of the connector.
HINT:
Compare one connector with the other 2 connectors.
OK:
No deformation is identified.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY CONNECTOR
Disconnection Detection Pin
C
C111732E05
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–152
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1140/32
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly RH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The side airbag sensor assembly RH circuit consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the
lateral deceleration sensor, etc.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, it judges
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1140/32 is recorded when a malfunction in the side airbag sensor assembly RH circuit is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1140/32
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the side airbag sensor assembly RH circuit for 2
seconds.
Side airbag sensor assembly RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Side airbag sensor assembly RH
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
S17
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly RH
ESR
RS
VUPR
SSR-
SSR+
1
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
15
A33 ESR
17
A33 VUPR
4
2
13
A33 SSR-
16
A33 SSR+
3
H043054E25
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–153
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
Center Airbag
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly
Sensor
Assembly RH
DLC3
DTC B1140/32
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1140/32 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1140/32 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
Go to step 2
TC
C110446E02
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the side airbag
sensor assembly RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–154
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Floor Wire
D
A
C
B Center airbag
Sensor Assembly
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly RH
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
A33
S17
VUPR
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S17-4 (VUPR) - S17-1
(ESR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
ESR
VUPR
ESR
Service Wire
C
C110451E08
Floor Wire
D
A
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly RH
RS
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the side airbag sensor assembly RH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A33-17 (VUPR) and A3315 (ESR) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S17
A33
SSR+
SSR-
Service Wire
C
C110450E08
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S17-3 (SSR+) - S17-2
(SSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
SSR-
SSR+
(d) Using a service wire, connect A33-16 (SSR+) and A3313 (SSR-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS–155
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Floor Wire
A
D
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S17-4 (VUPR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Connector “C”
S17-1 (ESR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S17
S17-3 (SSR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S17-2 (SSR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
SSR+
SSR-
VUPR
ESR
C
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
C109481E15
OK
5
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
Floor Wire
A
D
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S17
SSR+
VUPR
C
SSR-
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S17-4 (VUPR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S17-1 (ESR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S17-3 (SSR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S17-2 (SSR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
ESR
C109481E15
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–156
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
A
D
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S17-4 (VUPR) - S17-1
(ESR)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
S17-3 (SSR+) - S17-2
(SSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector “C”
S17
SSR+
VUPR
SSR-
ESR
C
C109481E15
OK
7
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY RH
RS
Center Airbag
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly
Sensor
Assembly LH
DTC B1140/32
DLC3
DTC B1141/33
CG
C
TC
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Interchange the side airbag sensor assembly RH with LH
and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
Result
C110449E02
NG:A
Proceed To
Display (DTC Output)
NG: A
DTC B1140/32 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1141/33 is output.
OK
DTC B1140/32 and B1141/33 are not
output.
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG:B
RS–157
REPLACE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY RH
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–158
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1141/33
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The side airbag sensor assembly LH circuit consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the
lateral deceleration sensor, etc.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, it judges
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1141/33 is recorded when a malfunction in the side airbag sensor assembly LH circuit is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1141/33
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the side airbag sensor assembly RH circuit for 2
seconds.
Side airbag sensor assembly LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Side airbag sensor assembly LH
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
S16
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly LH
ESL
RS
VUPL
SSL-
SSL+
1
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
18
A30 ESL
16
A30 VUPL
4
2
20
A30 SSL-
17
A30 SSL+
3
H043054E26
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–159
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
Side Airbag
Sensor
Assembly LH Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
DTC B1141/33
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1141/33 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1141/33 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
Go to step 2
TC
C110453E02
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the side airbag
sensor assembly LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–160
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (OPEN)
Floor Wire No. 2
D
A
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S16
VUPL
C
Specified condition
S16-4 (VUPL) - S16-1
(ESL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
VUPL
C110448E09
Floor Wire No. 2
D
A
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
RS
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S16
A30
SSL-
SSL-
(d) Using a service wire, connect A30-17 (SSL+) and A3020 (SSL-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S16-3 (SSL+) - S16-2
(SSL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
SSL+
Service Wire
C110447E09
OK
Condition
ESL
ESL
C
Tester connection
A30
Service Wire
SSL+
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the front airbag sensor assembly LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A30-16 (VUPL) and A3018 (ESL) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–161
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO B+)
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S16-4 (VUPL) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 V
Connector “C”
S16-1 (ESL) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 V
S16
S16-3 (SSL+) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 V
S16-2 (SSL-) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 V
SSL+
SSL-
VUPL
ESL
NG
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
C109479E18
OK
5
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO GROUND)
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S16
SSL+
VUPL
C
SSL-
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S16-4 (VUPL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S16-1 (ESL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S16-3 (SSL+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S16-2 (SSL-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
ESL
C109479E18
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
RS
RS–162
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT)
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D
C
B
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S16-4 (VUPL) - S16-1
(ESL)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
S16-3 (SSL+) - S16-2
(SSL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
Connector “C”
S16
SSL+
VUPL
SSLESL
C
C109479E18
OK
7
RS
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY LH
Side
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1140/32
DLC3
DTC B1141/33
CG
C
TC
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Interchange the side airbag sensor assembly RH with LH
and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
Result
C110452E02
NG:A
Proceed To
Display (DTC Output)
NG: A
DTC B1140/32 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1141/33 is output.
OK
DTC B1140/32 and B1141/33 are not
output.
REPLACE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY LH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG:B
RS–163
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–164
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1148/36 Front Airbag Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor RH circuit consists of the diagnosis circuit and the frontal deceleration sensor, etc.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the frontal deceleration sensor, it judges
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1148/36 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1148/36
•
•
Open circuit in +SR wire harness or -SR wire
harness of front airbag sensor RH circuit
Front airbag sensor RH sensor malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Front airbag sensor RH
Center airbag sensor assembly
Engine room main wire
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
A15
Front Airbag Sensor RH
+SR
-SR
RS
2
1
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
2
IN2
9
A32 +SR
1
IN2
20
A32 -SR
H002750E36
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1148/36
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1148/36 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1148/36 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
TC
Go to step 2
C110454E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the front airbag
sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECTOR CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–166
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (OPEN)
A
F
E
D C
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
Connector “B”
A15
A32
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the front airbag sensor RH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A32-9 (+SR) and A32-20 (SR) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-2 (+SR) - A15-1 (SR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
+SR
NG
+SR
-SR
Go to step 5
-SR
Service Wire
C
C123610E06
OK
4
RS
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1148/36
DLC3
DTC B1149/37
C
CG
TC
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(c) Interchange the front airbag sensor RH with LH, and
connect the connectors to them.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
Result
C110456E02
NG:A
Proceed To
Display (DTC Output)
NG: A
DTC B1148/36 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1149/37 is output.
OK
DTC B1148/36 and B1149/37 are not
output.
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG:B
RS–167
REPLACE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
5
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
F
A
E
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Engine Room Main Wire
Connector “C”
+SR
IN2
A32
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IN2-1 (+SR) - IN2-2 (-SR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Connector “B”
-SR
(a) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
engine room main wire.
HINT:
The service wire has already been inserted into
connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
+SR
-SR Service
Wire
C
C110457E07
OK
RS
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
RS–168
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1149/37 Front Airbag Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor LH circuit consists of the diagnosis circuit and the frontal deceleration sensor, etc.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the frontal deceleration sensor, it judges
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1149/37 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1149/37
•
•
Open circuit in +SL wire harness or -SL wire
harness of front airbag sensor LH circuit
Front airbag sensor LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Front airbag sensor LH
Center airbag sensor assembly
Engine room main wire
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
A14
Front Airbag Sensor LH
+SL
-SL
RS
2
1
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
2
IC1
15
A32 +SL
1
IC1
26
A32 -SL
H002750E37
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–169
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1149/37
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1149/37 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1149/37 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
Go to step 2
TC
C110458E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the front airbag
sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP1
RS
RS–170
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (OPEN)
A
F
E
D C
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
Connector “B”
A32
A14
+SL
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the front airbag sensor LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A32-15 (+SL) and A32-26
(-SL) of connector "B".
HINT:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-2 (+SL) - A14-1 (SL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 5
+SL
-SL
Service Wire
C
-SL
C123611E05
OK
4
RS
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
DC
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1148/36
DLC3
DTC B1149/37
CG
C
TC
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(c) Interchange the side airbag sensor RH with LH and
connect the connectors to them.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
Result
C110456E01
NG:A
Proceed To
Display (DTC Output)
NG: A
DTC B1148/36 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1149/37 is output.
OK
DTC B1148/36 and B1149/37 are not
output.
REPLACE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
RS–171
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG:B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
5
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
F
A
E
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Engine Room Main Wire
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
IC1
A32
-SL
(a) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
engine room main wire.
HINT:
The service wire has already been inserted into
connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IC1-2 (+SL) - IC1-1 (-SL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
+SL +SL
SST
-SL
C
C110460E06
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
RS
RS–172
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1150/23 Occupant Classification System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification system circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the occupant
classification ECU.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the occupant classification ECU, it determines
whether or not the front passenger airbag assembly and the front seat airbag assembly RH should be
operated.
DTC B1150/23 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification system circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1150/23
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short signal, open signal, short to ground signal or
B+ short signal in the occupant classification
system circuit for 2 seconds.
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
8
FSR+ O3
1
Bl1
3
1
A33 A34 FSR+
(*1) (*2)
4
O3
4
Bl1
2 10
A33 A34 FSR(*1) (*2)
RS
FSR-
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
C116312E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC (OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 10 seconds.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–173
(b) Using the intelligent tester, check the DTCs of the
occupant classification ECU (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
GO TO OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK DTC (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY)
DC
Occupant Classification
ECU
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1150/23
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1150/23 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1150/23 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
Go to step 3
TC
C110461E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
3
RS
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the occupant
classification ECU.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS–174
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT TO GROUND)
F
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the occupant classification ECU.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
A
E
DC
Occupant
Classification
ECU
B Center Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O3-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 8
Connector “E”
O3
FSR-
FSR+
C
C110462E30
OK
5
RS
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT TO B+)
F
E
DC
Occupant
Classification
ECU
A
B Center Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O3-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Connector “E”
O3
FSR-
FSR+
C
C110462E30
OK
Go to step 9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
6
RS–175
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT)
F
A
E
DC
Occupant
Classification
ECU
B Center Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - O3-4
(FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 10
Connector “E”
O3
FSR-
FSR+
C
C110462E30
OK
RS
RS–176
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (OPEN)
A
E D C B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Occupant Classification
ECU
Connector “B”
F
A33 (*1)
Connector “E”
FSR-
O3
Service
Wire
FSR-
FSR+
A34 (*2)
FSR+
*1: with Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
FSRC
RS
Service Wire
C111721E12
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - O3-4
(FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
FSR+
(a) with Side and curtain shield airbag:
Using a service wire, connect A33-1 (FSR+) and A33-2
(FSR-) of connector "B".
(b) without Side and curtain shield airbag:
Using a service wire, connect A34-3 (FSR+) and A34-10
(FSR-) of connector "B".
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Go to step 11
RS–177
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
8
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
F
A
E
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Floor Wire
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
Bl1-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector “C”
Bl1
FSR+
FSRC
C110464E19
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–178
9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
F
A
E
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Floor Wire
Connector “C”
Bl1
FSR+
C110464E19
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
Condition
Specified condition
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Bl1-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
FSRC
Tester connection
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Body
ground
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS–179
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
10
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
F
A
E
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
Bl1-1 (FSR+) -Bl1-4
(FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Floor Wire
Connector “C”
Bl1
FSR+
FSRC
C110464E19
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–180
11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
Floor Wire
F
A
E
D C
B
Occupant Classification
ECU
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
HINT:
The service wire has already been inserted into
connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Connector “B”
A33 (*1)
Connector “C”
FSR+
Bl1
FSR+
A34 (*2)
FSR+
FSR*1: with Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
FSRC
Service Wire
C111722E08
OK
RS
Condition
Specified condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Service
Wire
FSR-
Tester connection
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Bl1-4
(FSR-)
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1152/28
RS–181
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator Circuit
Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator. This circuit indicates the operation condition of the front passenger
airbag assembly, the front seat airbag assembly RH and front seat belt pretensioner RH.
DTC B1152/28 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1152/28
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short signal, open signal, short to ground signal or
B+ short signal in the passenger airbag ON/OFF
indicator circuit for 2 seconds.
Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Air conditioning control assembly (Passenger
airbag ON/OFF indicator)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
RS
RS–182
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
D3 Air Conditioning Control Assembly
PAON
P-AB
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
25
A32 PAON
13
1
A32 P-AB
6
J20
J/C
J25
J/C
IG+
2
A
GND
7
B 3F
Center
J/B
A
I18
Ignition SW
2 AM1
H
J7
J/C
H
A
A
Driver Side J/B
2
1C
IG1 4
IG1
8
1J
Engine Room R/B
AM1
2
B 3F
2
2
ALT
1
2
1
2
27
A32 E1
2
28
A32 E2
A
J24
J/C
RS
Battery
II
IJ
IH
H045967E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CONDITION
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
operation.
HINT:
Refer to the normal condition of the passenger airbag
ON/OFF indicator (See page RS-28).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–183
ON
Ignition Switch
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
(”ON”)
2 sec.
4 sec.
2 sec.
ON
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
(”OFF”)
4 sec.
ON
OFF
ON/OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
H043700E01
Result
ON/OFF Indicator Illumination
Proceed to
Always ON
A
OFF
B
B
Go to step 10
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the air conditioning
control assembly.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTORS
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the air conditioning control assembly.
(b) Check that the connectors (on the center airbag sensor
assembly side and the air conditioning control assembly
side) are not damaged.
RS
RS–184
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
The connectors are not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
OK
4
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
H045951
(a) Connect the connector to the air conditioning control
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
operation.
OK:
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator ("ON" and
"OFF") does not come on.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
5
RS
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1152/28
CG TC
C
C110466E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1152/28 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1152/28 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
6
RS–185
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Connector “B”
Connector “C”
P-AB
A32 P-AB
D3
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the air conditioning
control assembly.
(d) Using a service wire, connect A32-1 (P-AB) and A32-25
(PAON) of connector "B".
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - D3-13
(PAON)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
PAON
Service Wire
PAON
C123759E01
OK
7
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the SST from connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Connector “C”
P-AB
D3
PAON
C123760E01
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - D3-13
(PAON)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–186
8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
D3-13 (PAON) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
P-AB
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
D3
PAON
C123760E01
OK
9
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D3-13 (PAON) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Connector “C”
P-AB
NG
D3
PAON
C123760E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–187
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
10
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the air conditioning
control assembly.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS
OK
11
CHECK CONNECTORS
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the air conditioning control assembly.
(b) Check that the connectors (on the center airbag sensor
assembly side and the air conditioning control assembly
side) are not damaged.
OK:
The connectors are not deformed or damaged.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–188
12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Connector “B”
Connector “C”
P-AB
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the telltale light assembly.
(d) Using a service wire, connect A32-1 (P-AB) and A32-25
(PAON) of connector "B".
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - D3-13
(PAON)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A32 P-AB
D3
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
PAON
Service Wire
PAON
C123759E01
OK
13
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Connector “C”
P-AB
D3
PAON
C123760E01
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - D3-13
(PAON)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
14
RS–189
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
D3-13 (PAON) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
P-AB
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
D3
PAON
C123760E01
OK
15
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Instrument Panel Wire
D
A
C
Air Conditioning
Control Assembly
B
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-6 (P-AB) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D3-13 (PAON) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Connector “C”
P-AB
NG
D3
PAON
C123760E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–190
16
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY (POWER SOURCE)
Air Conditioning
Control
Assembly Side:
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Voltage and Resistance
D3
IG+
GND
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D3-2 (IG+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
D3-7 (GND) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
H045953E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS (AIR
CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY BATTERY) OR BATTERY
OK
17
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
A32
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the telltale light assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator condition.
Result
P-AB
PAON
H040065E24
RS
Tester connection
Condition
Passenger airbag ON/
OFF indicator condition
A32-25 (PAON) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
"ON" comes on
A32-1 (P-AB) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
"OFF" comes on
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
18
RS–191
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1152/28
CG TC
C
C110466E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1152/28 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1152/28 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–192
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1153/25
Seat Position Airbag Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The seat position airbag sensor circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the seat
position airbag sensor.
DTC B1153/25 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the seat position airbag sensor circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B1153/25
When one of the following conditions is met:
• The center airbag sensor assembly detects a line
short signal, open signal, short to ground signal, or
short to B+ signal in the seat position airbag sensor
circuit.
• Seat position airbag sensor malfunction
• Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Seat position airbag sensor
Center airbag sensor assembly
Front seat inner belt assembly LH
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
6
1
B12
3
4
A31 A30 LSP+
(*2) (*1)
2
5
B12
8
3
A31 A30 LSP-
RS
(*2) (*1)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
C
C145320E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–193
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
A
F
DC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
DTC B1153/25
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1153/25 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1153/25 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
TC
C
C145326E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTORS
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly, seat position airbag
sensor and front seat inner belt assembly LH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
HINT:
If the connectors are not connected securely, reconnect
the connectors and proceed to the next inspection.
(d) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly, seat position airbag sensor and front seat
inner belt assembly LH.
(e) Check that the terminals of the connectors are not
damaged.
OK:
The terminals are not deformed or damaged.
RS–194
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
3
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR CIRCUIT (OPEN)
F
A
E
DC
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
(*1)
LSP-
LSP+
Service Wire
Connector B
A31
(*2)
LSP+
RS
LSPService Wire
C
C145329E01
OK
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
*1: with Side and curtain shield airbag
*2: without Side and curtain shield airbag
Connector B
A30
(a) Using a service wire, connect terminals LSP+ and LSPof connector B.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
connector E according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
NG
Go to step 10
RS–195
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR CIRCUIT (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
A
F
E
DC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
Always
1MΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
Always
1MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 11
Connector E
C
C145330E01
OK
5
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR CIRCUIT (SHORT)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
E
DC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Specified Condition
Always
1MΩ or higher
NG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
C145330E01
OK
Condition
1-2
B
Connector E
C
Tester Connection
A
F
Go to step 12
RS
RS–196
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR CIRCUIT (SHORT TO B+)
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
A
F
E
DC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
2 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 13
Connector E
C
C145330E01
OK
7
RS
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
A
F
DC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1153/25
TC
C145326E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the seat position airbag
sensor and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1153/25 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1153/25 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–197
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
8
REPLACE SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the seat position airbag sensor. (See page RS443).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
A
F
DC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
DTC B1153/25
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1153/25 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1153/25 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
TC
C145326E01
OK
END
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–198
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (OPEN)
Front Seat Inner Belt
Assembly LH
Floor Wire No. 2
F
A
E
D C
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector C
LSP+
A30
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B12-2 (LSP+) - B12-4
(LSP-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
*1: with Side and curtain shield airbag
*2: without Side and curtain shield airbag
Connector B
LSP+
(a) Disconnect the front seat inner belt assembly LH
connector from the floor wire No. 2 connector.
HINT:
The service wire has already been inserted into
connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance of connector C according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
NG
REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
LSP-
(*1)
B12
LSPService Wire
Connector B
A31
(*2)
LSP+
Service Wire
RS
C
LSPC145333E01
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
RS–199
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
11
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO GROUND)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Floor Wire No. 2
A
F
E
DC
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the front seat inner belt assembly LH
connector from the floor wire No. 2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B12-2 (LSP+) - Body
ground
Always
1MΩ or higher
B12-4 (LSP-) - Body
ground
Always
1MΩ or higher
NG
Connector C
REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
B12
LSP+
LSPC
C145334E01
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
RS
RS–200
12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Floor Wire No. 2
A
F
E
DC
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the front seat inner belt assembly LH
connector from the floor wire No. 2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B12-2 (LSP+) - B12-4
(LSP-)
Always
1MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
Connector C
B12
LSP+
LSPC
C145334E01
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
RS
RS–201
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
13
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO B+)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly LH
Floor Wire No. 2
A
F
E
DC
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector C
B12
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the front seat inner belt assembly LH
connector from the floor wire No. 2 connector.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B12-2 (LSP+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
B12-4 (LSP-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
LSP+
NG
REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
LSPC
C145334E01
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–37
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 111213 141516
TC
A082779E07
Normal System Code (w/o Past Trouble Code)
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
Normal System Code (w/ Past Trouble Code)
0.75 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
Trouble Code (Example Codes 11 and 31)
0.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
4.0 sec.
ON
OFF
1.5 sec. 0.5 sec.
DTC 11
Repeat
DTC 31
H013050E02
DTC CHECK (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Check the DTCs (Present trouble code).
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON, and wait for
approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Connect the terminals to the correct
positions to avoid a malfunction.
(b) Check the DTCs (Past trouble code).
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Connect the terminals to the correct
positions to avoid a malfunction.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON, and wait for
approximately 60 seconds.
(c) Read the DTCs.
(1) Read the blinking patterns of the DTCs. As
examples, the blinking patterns for the normal
system code and trouble codes 11 and 31 are
shown in the illustration.
• Normal system code indication (without past
trouble code)
The light blinks twice per second.
• Normal system code indication (with past
trouble code)
When the past trouble code is stored in the
center airbag sensor assembly, the light
blinks only once per second.
• Trouble code indication
The first two blinkings indicate the first DTC.
The second blinking occurs after a 1.5second pause.
If there are more than 1 code, there will be a 2.5second pause between each code. After all
codes are shown, there will be a 4.0-second
pause, and they all will be repeated.
HINT:
• If 2 or more malfunctions are found, the
indication begins with the smaller numbered
code.
• If DTCs are indicated without connecting the
terminals, proceed to the "TC and CG
Terminal Circuit" (See page RS-284).
RS
RS–38
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2.
RS
DTC CLEAR (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Clear the DTCs.
(1) When the ignition switch is turned off, the DTCs
are cleared.
HINT:
Depending on the DTC, the code may not be
cleared by turning off the ignition switch. In this
case, proceed to the next procedure.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3, and then turn the ignition switch to the
ON position.
SST 09843-18040
(3) Disconnect terminal TC of the DLC3 within 3 to
10 seconds after the DTCs are output, and
check if the SRS warning light comes on after 3
seconds.
(4) Within 2 to 4 seconds after the SRS warning
light comes on, connect terminals TC and CG of
the DLC3.
(5) The SRS warning light should go off within 2 to 4
seconds after connecting terminals TC and CG
of the DLC3. Then, disconnect terminal TC
within 2 to 4 seconds after the SRS warning light
goes off.
(6) The SRS warning light comes on again within 2
to 4 seconds after disconnecting terminal TC.
Then, reconnect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3 within 2 to 4 seconds after the SRS
warning light comes on.
RS–39
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(7) Check if the SRS warning light goes off within 2
to 4 seconds after connecting terminals TC and
CG of the DLC3. Also check if the normal
system code is output within 1 second after the
SRS warning light goes off.
If DTCs are not cleared, repeat this procedure
until the codes are cleared.
ON
Ignition Switch
LOCK
Open
DLC3 (TC and CG)
Short
SRS Warning Light (*)
0.5 sec. 0.5 sec.
0.25 sec. 0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
T1: 0 to ∞ sec.
1.5 sec.
T2: approx. 6 sec.
T3: 3 to 5 sec.
T1
T4: 3 to 10 sec.
T2
T3
T4
T5 T6 T5 T6 T5 T6 T5 T7
T5: 2 to 4 sec.
T6: 1 to 5 sec.
T7: within 1 sec.
*: The past trouble code in the illustration shows DTC 21 as an example.
C
C109537E02
3.
Intelligent Tester
A066288E01
DTC CHECK
(a) Check the DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Check the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
(b) Clear the DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
RS
RS–40
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
Intelligent Tester
1.
A066288E01
RS
CHECK MODE (SIGNAL CHECK): DTC CHECK
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Select the "SIGNAL CHECK", and proceed
checking using the intelligent tester.
NOTICE:
Select the "SIGNAL CHECK" from the "DTC
CHECK" screen displayed on the intelligent
tester to clear the output DTCs (both present
and past).
HINT:
• DTCs can be detected more sensitively in check
mode than in normal diagnosis mode.
• Perform check mode inspection when a
malfunction in each squib circuit is suspected
even after the normal system code is output
through normal diagnosis mode inspection.
RS–202
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1154/38 Rear Airbag Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The rear airbag sensor RH circuit consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral
deceleration sensor, etc.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, it judges
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1154/38 is recorded when a malfunction in the rear airbag sensor RH circuit is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1154/38
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the rear airbag sensor RH circuit for 2 seconds.
Rear airbag sensor RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Rear airbag sensor RH
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center airbag
Sensor assembly
S19
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
ESCR 1
VUCR 4
20
A33 ESCR
19
A33 VUCR
RS
CSR-
2
CSR+ 3
4
A33 CSR-
18
A33 CSR+
H043054E27
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–203
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1154/38
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1154/38 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1154/38 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
CG
C
Go to step 2
TC
C111661E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the rear airbag
sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–204
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Floor Wire
A
D
C
B
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S19
A33
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the rear airbag sensor RH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A33-19 (VUCR) and A3320 (ESCR) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-4 (VUCR) - S19-1
(ESCR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
ESCR
Service
Wire
VUCR
VUCR
ESCR
C
C111713E08
Floor Wire
A
D
C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
RS
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S19
A33
Service
Wire
C
CSR-
CSR+
C111714E08
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-3 (CSR+) - S19-2
(CSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
CSR-
CSR+
(d) Using a service wire, connect A33-18 (CSR+) and A33-4
(CSR-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS–205
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Floor Wire
D
A
C
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S19
CSR+
CSR-
VUCR
ESCR
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-4 (VUCR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S19-1 (ESCR) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S19-3 (CSR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S19-2 (CSR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
C109485E16
OK
5
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
Floor Wire
D
A
C
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
CSR+
VUCR
C
S19
CSR-
ESCR
C109485E16
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-4 (VUCR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S19-1 (ESCR) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S19-3 (CSR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S19-2 (CSR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–206
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard
Floor Wire
D
A
C
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-4 (VUCR) - S19-1
(ESCR)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S19-3 (CSR+) - S19-2
(CSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector “C”
CSR+
VUCR
S19
CSR-
ESCR
C
C109485E16
OK
7
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR RH
RS
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
DTC B1154/38
CG
TC
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Interchange the rear airbag sensor LH with RH and
connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
Result
DTC B1155/39
C
C111662E01
NG:A
Proceed To
Display (DTC Output)
NG: A
DTC B1154/38 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1155/39 is output.
OK
DTC B1154/38 and B1155/39 are not
output.
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG:B
RS–207
REPLACE REAR AIRBAG SENSOR RH
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–208
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1155/39 Rear Airbag Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The rear airbag sensor LH circuit consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral
deceleration sensor, etc.
If the center airbag sensor assembly receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, it judges
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1155/39 is recorded when a malfunction in the rear airbag sensor LH circuit is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1155/39
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal,, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the rear airbag sensor LH circuit for 2 seconds.
Rear airbag sensor LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Rear airbag sensor LH
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
S18
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
ESCL
VUCL
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
1
4
13
A30 ESCL
14
A30 VUCL
RS
CSL-
CSL+
2
3
1
A30 CSL-
15
A30 CSL+
H043054E28
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–209
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1155/39
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1155/39 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1155/39 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
C
CG
Go to step 2
TC
C111663E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and the rear airbag
sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–210
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (OPEN)
Floor Wire No. 2
D
A
C
B
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S18
A30
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly and the rear airbag sensor LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A30-14 (VUCL) and A3013 (ESCL) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-4 (VUCL) - S18-1
(ESCL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
ESCL
VUCL
ESCL Service Wire
VUCL
C
C111715E12
Floor Wire No. 2
D
A
C
B
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
RS
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
S18
A30
CSL-
CSL+
CSL-
OK
CSL+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-3 (CSL+) S18-2 (CSL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Service
Wire
C
(d) Using a service wire, connect A30-15 (CSL+) and A30-1
(CSL-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
C111716E12
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–211
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO B+)
(a) Disconnect SST from connector "B".
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D
C
B
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S18
CSL+
CSL-
VUCL
ESCL
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-4 (VUCL) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S18-1 (ESCL) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S18-3 (CSL+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S18-2 (CSL-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
C109483E16
OK
5
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D
C
B
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
S18
C
CSL+
CSL-
VUCL
ESCL
Condition
Specified condition
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S18-1 (ESCL) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S18-3 (CSL+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
S18-2 (CSL-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
C109483E16
OK
Tester connection
S18-4 (VUCL) - Body
ground
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
RS
RS–212
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (SHORT)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard
Floor Wire No. 2
A
D
C
B
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-4 (VUCL) - S18-1
(ESCL)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
S18-3 (CSL+) - S18-2
(CSL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
Connector “C”
S18
CSL+
CSL-
VUCL
ESCL
C
C109483E16
OK
7
RS
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Interchange the rear airbag sensor LH with RH and
connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
Result
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
DTC B1154/38
CG
C
TC
DTC B1155/39
Proceed to
C111664E01
NG: A
NG: B
OK
NG:A
Display (DTC output)
DTC B1154/38 is output.
DTC B1155/39 is output.
DTC B1154/38 and B1155/39 are not
output.
REPLACE REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG:B
RS–213
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–397
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
SPIRAL CABLE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
“TORX” SCREW
“TORX” SCREW
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
STEERING COLUMN
COVER UPPER
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
SPIRAL CABLE
50 (510, 37)
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
RS
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
STEERING COLUMN
COVER LOWER
STEERING PAD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C
C131315E02
RS–398
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
REMOVAL
H042177
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
(See page RS-387)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
(See page RS-388)
6.
REMOVE STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
7.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-9)
8.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER
(a) Remove the 3 screws and steering column cover
lower.
9.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPPER
(a) Remove the steering column cover upper.
10. REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the spiral cable.
RS
H042178
RS–214
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1160/83 Short in Curtain Shield Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain airbag
assembly RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1160/83 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1160/83
•
•
Short circuit between ICR+ wire harness and ICRwire harness of curtain shield squib RH
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly RH (Curtain shield
squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
C17
Curtain Shield Squib RH
1
RS
2
8
A33 ICR+
7
A33 ICR-
C128524E25
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent test.
(See page RS-38).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–215
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C17
DLC3
CG
SST
DTC B1630/83
TC
C
C111665E07
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH (Curtain shield squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1160/83 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1160/83 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) from the floor
wire.
RS
RS–216
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(d) Check that the floor wire connector (on the curtain shield
airbag assembly RH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, and the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
A
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
ICR-
C17
C
RS
C111666E27
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C17-1 (ICR+) - C17-2
(ICR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
ICR+
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–217
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D C Center Airbag
Curtain Shield Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1160/83
TC
C111667E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1160/83 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1160/83 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–218
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1161/84 Open in Curtain Shield Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1161/84 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1161/84
Open circuit in ICR+ wire harness or ICR- wire
harness of curtain shield squib RH
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly RH (Curtain shield
squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-211.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
RS
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C17
DLC3
CG
C
SST
DTC B1631/84
TC
C111674E06
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH (Curtain shield squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS–219
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B1161/84 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1161/84 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C17-1 (ICR+) - C17-2
(ICR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector “C”
ICR+
ICR-
C17
RS
C
C111666E27
OK
RS–220
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D C Center Airbag
Curtain Shield Sensor Assembly
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1161/84
TC
C111673E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1161/84 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1161/84 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–221
Short to GND in Curtain Shield Squib RH Circuit
B1162/81
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1162/81 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1162/81
•
•
Short circuit in curtain shield squib RH wire harness
(to ground)
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly RH (Curtain shield
squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-211.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–222
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C17
DLC3
CG
C
SST
DTC B1632/81
TC
C111675E06
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH (Curtain shield squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1162/81 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1162/81 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH
Go to step 2
RS–223
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Floor Wire
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C17-1 (ICR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
C17-2 (ICR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector “C”
ICR+
ICR-
C17
C
C111666E27
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1162/81
TC
C111676E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1162/81 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1162/81 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–224
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1163/82 Short to B+ in Curtain Shield Squib RH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1163/82 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1163/82
Short circuit in curtain shield squib RH wire harness
(to B+)
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly RH (Curtain shield
squib RH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-211.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
RS
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C17
DLC3
CG
C
SST
DTC B1633/82
TC
C111679E06
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH (Curtain shield squib RH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS–225
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B1163/82 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1163/82 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
Floor Wire
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
ICR+
ICR-
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C17-1 (ICR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
C17-2 (ICR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
C17
RS
C
C111666E27
OK
RS–226
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1163/82
TC
C111678E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly RH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1163/82 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1163/82 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–227
B1165/87 Short in Curtain Shield Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1165/87 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1165/87
•
•
Short circuit between ICL+ wire harness and ICLwire harness of curtain shield squib LH
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly LH (Curtain shield
squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
C16
Curtain Shield Squib LH
1
2
9
A30 ICL+
10
A30 ICL-
RS
C128524E26
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
RS–228
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C16
DLC3
CG
SST
DTC B1165/87
TC
C
C111681E07
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH (curtain shield squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1165/87 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1165/87 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) from the floor
wire No. 2.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–229
(d) Check that the floor wire No. 2 connector (on the curtain
shield airbag assembly LH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, and the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
OK
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Floor Wire No. 2
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C16-1 (ICL+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
C16-2 (ICL-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
Connector “C”
NG
ICL+
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
ICL-
C16
C
C111682E21
OK
RS
RS–230
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1165/87
TC
C111683E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1165/87 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1165/87 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–231
B1166/88 Open in Curtain Shield Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1166/88 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1166/88
Open circuit in ICL+ wire harness or ICL- wire
harness of curtain shield squib LH
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly LH (Curtain shield
squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-224.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C16
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1166/88
TC
C111684E07
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH (curtain shield squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS
RS–232
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B1166/88 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1166/88 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C16-1 (ICL+) - C16-2
(ICL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
Floor Wire No. 2
NG
Connector “C”
ICL+
ICL-
C16
RS
C
C111682E21
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3
RS–233
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1166/88
TC
C111685E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1166/88 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1166/88 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–234
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1167/85 Short to GND in Curtain Shield Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1167/85 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1167/85
Short circuit in curtain shield squib LH wire harness
(to ground)
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly LH (Curtain Shield
Squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-224.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
RS
Connector “C”
C16
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1167/85
TC
C111686E07
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH (curtain shield squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–235
OK:
DTC B1167/85 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1167/85 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Floor Wire No. 2
Condition
Specified condition
C16-1 (ICL+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
C16-2 (ICL-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
ICL+
Tester connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
ICL-
C16
RS
C
C111682E21
OK
RS–236
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1167/85
TC
C111687E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1167/85 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1167/85 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–237
B1168/86 Short to B+ in Curtain Shield Squib LH Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the curtain shield
airbag assembly LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1168/86 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1168/86
Short circuit in curtain shield squib LH wire harness
(to B+)
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
•
•
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Curtain shield airbag assembly LH (Curtain shield
squib LH)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire No. 2
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-224.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
C16
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1168/86
TC
C111688E08
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the floor wire No. 2.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH (curtain shield squib LH) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
RS
RS–238
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
DTC B1168/86 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1168/86 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO. 2 (CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
A
D C
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Floor Wire No. 2
Connector “C”
ICL+
RS
C111682E21
OK
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C16-1 (ICL+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
C16-2 (ICL-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
ICL-
C16
C
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO. 2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3
RS–239
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1168/86
TC
C111689E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1168/86 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1168/86 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–41
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC Code
B0100/13
B0101/14
B0102/11
B0103/12
B0105/53
B0106/54
B0107/51
Detection Item
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Short in Driver Side
Squib Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver side squib)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
Trouble Area
*2
ON
RS-46
Open in Driver Side
Squib Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver side squib)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-51
Short to GND in
Driver Side Squib
Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver side squib)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-56
Short to B+ in Driver
Side Squib Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver side squib)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-61
Short in Front
Passenger Side
Squib Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag assembly
(Front passenger
side squib)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-66
Open in Front
Passenger Side
Squib Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side
squib)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-69
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side
Squib Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side
squib)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-72
RS
RS–42
DTC Code
B0108/52
B0110/43
B0111/44
B0112/41
RS
B0113/42
B0115/47
B0116/48
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Detection Item
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side
Squib Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side
squib)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
Trouble Area
*2
ON
RS-75
Short in Side Squib
RH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly RH (Side
squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-79
Open in Side Squib
RH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly RH (Side
squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-82
Short to GND in Side
Squib RH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly RH (Side
squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-85
Short to B+ in Side
Squib RH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly RH (Side
squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-88
Short in Side Squib
LH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly LH (Side
squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-91
Open in Side Squib
LH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly LH (Side
squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-94
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC Code
B0117/45
B0118/46
B0126/27
B0127/27
B0130/63
B0131/64
B0132/61
Detection Item
Trouble Area
RS–43
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Short to GND in Side
Squib LH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly LH (Side
squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-97
Short to B+ in Side
Squib LH Circuit
1. Front seat side
airbag
assembly LH (Side
squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-100
Seat Belt Buckle
Switch LH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Front seat inner
belt
assembly LH (Seat
belt
buckle switch LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
ON
RS-103
Seat Belt Buckle
Switch LH
Malfunction
1. Front seat inner
belt
assembly LH (Seat
belt
buckle switch LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
ON
RS-103
Short in Front
Pretensioner Squib
RH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-109
Open in Front
Pretensioner Squib
RH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-113
Short to GND in Front
Pretensioner Squib
RH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-116
RS
RS–44
DTC Code
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Short to B+ in Front
Pretensioner Squib
RH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly RH (Front
pretensioner squib
RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-119
Short in Front
Pretensioner Squib
LH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-123
Open in Front
Pretensioner Squib
LH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-127
Short to GND in Front
Pretensioner Squib
LH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-130
Short to B+ in Front
Pretensioner Squib
LH Circuit
1. Front seat outer
belt
assembly LH (Front
pretensioner squib
LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-133
B1100/31
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Malfunction
1. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
2. Engine room main
wire
3. Instrument panel
wire
*1
ON
RS-137
B1135/24
Half Connection in
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Connectors
1. Electrical
connection
check mechanism
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
*1
ON
RS-147
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly RH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Side airbag sensor
RH
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*1
Blink
RS-149
B0133/62
B0135/73
B0136/74
B0137/71
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B0138/72
B1140/32
Detection Item
Trouble Area
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC Code
Trouble Area
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly LH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Side airbag sensor
LH
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*1
Blink
RS-155
Front Airbag Sensor
RH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Front airbag
sensor RH
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Engine room main
wire
4. Instrument panel
wire
*1
ON
RS-161
Front Airbag Sensor
LH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Front airbag
sensor LH
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Engine room main
wire
4. Instrument panel
wire
*1
ON
RS-165
B1150/23
Occupant
Classification System
Malfunction
1. Occupant
classification ECU
2. Center airbag
sensor
3. Floor wire
4. Front seat wire No.
1
*1
ON
RS-169
B1152/28
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
Circuit Malfunction
1. Air conditioning
control assembly
2. Center airbag
sensor
3. Instrument panel
wire
*1
ON
RS-178
Seat Position Airbag
Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
1. Seat position
airbag sensor
2. Center airbag
sensor assembly
3. Front seat inner
belt assembly LH
4. Floor wire No. 2
*1
ON
RS-189
Rear Airbag Sensor
RH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Rear airbag sensor
RH
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*1
Blink
RS-199
Rear Airbag Sensor
LH Circuit
Malfunction
1. Rear airbag sensor
LH
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*1
Blink
RS-205
Short in Curtain
Shield Squib RH
Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly RH
(Curtain
shield squib RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-211
B1141/33
B1148/36
B1149/37
B1153/25
B1154/38
B1155/39
B1160/83
Detection Item
RS–45
RS
RS–46
DTC Code
B1161/84
B1162/81
B1163/82
B1165/87
B1166/88
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Detection Item
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Open in Curtain
Shield Squib RH
Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly RH
(Curtain
shield squib RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-215
Short to GND in
Curtain Shield Squib
RH Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly RH
(Curtain
shield squib RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-218
Short to B+ in Curtain
Shield Squib RH
Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly RH
(Curtain
shield squib RH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire
*2
Blink
RS-221
Short in Curtain
Shield Squib LH
Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly LH (Curtain
shield squib LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-224
Open in Curtain
Shield Squib LH
Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly LH (Curtain
shield squib LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-228
Short to GND in
Curtain Shield Squib
LH Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly LH (Curtain
shield squib LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-231
Short to B+ in Curtain
Shield Squib LH
Circuit
1. Curtain shield
airbag
assembly LH (Curtain
shield squib LH)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Floor wire No. 2
*2
Blink
RS-234
RS
B1167/85
B1168/86
Trouble Area
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC Code
B1180/17
B1181/18
B1182/19
B1183/22
B1185/57
B1186/58
Detection Item
Trouble Area
RS–47
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Short in Driver Side
Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver
side squib 2nd step)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-237
Open in Driver Side
Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver
side squib 2nd step)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-242
Short to GND in
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver
side squib 2nd step)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-247
Short to B+ in Driver
Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Steering pad
(Driver
side squib 2nd step)
2. Spiral cable
3. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
4. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-252
Short in Front
Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side squib
2nd
step)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-257
Open in Front
Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side squib
2nd
step)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-260
RS
RS–48
DTC Code
B1187/55
B1188/56
B1628/29
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side squib
2nd
step)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-263
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
1. Front passenger
airbag
assembly (Front
passenger side squib
2nd
step)
2. Center airbag
sensor
assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*2
ON
RS-266
Roll Over Cut Off
Indicator Malfunction
1. Combination meter
assembly
2. Center airbag
sensor assembly
3. Instrument panel
wire
*1
Blink
RS-270
RS–240
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1180/17 Short in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and
the steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1180/17 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the driver side squib 2nd step circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1180/17
•
•
•
Short circuit between D2+ wire harness and D2wire harness of driver side squib 2nd step
Driver side squib 2nd step malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
4
RS
3
16
A32 D2+
17
A32 D2-
A36
Spiral Cable
H001451E48
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–241
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP)
Spiral Cable
F E
DC
Driver Side
Squib 2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
SST
Color: Black
DLC3
CG
DTC B1180/17
TC
C
C111690E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib 2nd step) for measurement, as this may
lead to a serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1180/17 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1180/17 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) from the spiral
cable.
(d) Check that the spiral cable connector (on the steering
pad side) is not damaged.
RS
RS–242
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, and the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
OK
3
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP CIRCUIT
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
DC
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
D2-
Go to step 5
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111719E01
OK
RS
4
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
F E
DC
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
DLC3
CG
DTC B1180/17
TC
H042137E02
(a) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1180/17 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1180/17 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
RS–243
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
5
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable.
HINT:
The activation prevention mechanism of connector "B"
has already been released.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-4 (D2+) - A36-3 (D2)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
A36
D2+
D2C
C110388E32
OK
RS
RS–244
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
Instrument Panel Wire
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "D" (See page RS-28).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector E
D2-
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111718E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–245
B1181/18 Open in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and
the steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1181/18 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the driver side squib 2nd step circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1181/18
•
•
•
Open circuit in D2+ wire harness or D2- wire
harness of driver side squib 2nd step
Driver side squib 2nd step malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-237.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–246
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP)
Spiral Cable
DC
F E
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
SST
Color: Black
DLC3
CG
DTC B1181/18
TC
C
C111691E01
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib 2nd step) for measurement, as this may
lead to a serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1181/18 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1181/18 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
Go to step 2
RS–247
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
DC
B
Spiral Cable
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
Below 1 Ω
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
NG
Go to step 4
Connector E
D2-
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111719E03
OK
3
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Spiral Cable
FE
DC
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
DLC3
CG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1181/18
TC
H042140E02
(a) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1181/18 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1181/18 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–248
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-4 (D2+) - A36-3 (D2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
Connector “C”
A36
D2+
D2C
C110388E32
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
Instrument Panel Wire
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
RS
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
D2+
Color: Black
C
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
Below 1 Ω
B
Connector E
D2-
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
C111718E01
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–249
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–401
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 2
DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
20 (200, 14)
RS
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131316E01
RS–402
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the front passenger airbag assembly installed
on the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are
any defects as mentioned below, replace the
instrument panel with a new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
instrument panel around the front passenger airbag
assembly.
2.
C131324
INSPECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
HAS NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the front passenger airbag assembly removed
from the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are
any defects as mentioned below, replace the front
passenger airbag assembly, instrument panel or
instrument panel reinforcement with a new one:
• Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on
the front passenger airbag assembly.
• Cracks or other damage to the connectors.
• Deformation or cracks on the instrument panel or
instrument panel reinforcement.
HINT:
There should be no interference between the
instrument panel and the front passenger airbag
assembly.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
RS
C123767
RS–250
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Short to GND in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
B1182/19
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and
the steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1182/19 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the driver side squib 2nd step circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1182/19
•
•
•
Short circuit in driver side squib 2nd step wire
harness (to ground)
Driver side squib 2nd step malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-237.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–251
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP)
DC
F E
Spiral Cable
Driver Side
Squib 2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
SST
Color: Black
DLC3
CG
DTC B1182/19
TC
C
C111692E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib 2nd step) for measurement, as this may
lead to a serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1182/19 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1182/19 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
Go to step 2
RS
RS–252
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
DC
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
D2- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 4
Connector E
D2-
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111719E01
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Spiral Cable
RS
FE
DC
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
DLC3
CG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1182/19
TC
H042142E02
(a) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1182/19 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1182/19 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–253
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-4 (D2+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A36-3 (D2-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
Connector “C”
A36
D2+
D2C
C110388E32
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
Instrument Panel Wire
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
D2- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector E
D2-
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111718E01
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
RS
RS–254
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–255
Short to B+ in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
B1183/22
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and
the steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1183/22 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the driver side squib 2nd step circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1183/22
•
•
•
Short circuit in driver side squib 2nd step wire
harness (to B+)
Driver side squib 2nd step malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-237.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–256
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP)
Spiral Cable
DC
F E
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
SST
Color: Black
DLC3
CG
DTC B1183/22
TC
C
C111693E01
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib 2nd step) for measurement, as this may
lead to a serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1183/22 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1183/22 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
Go to step 2
RS–257
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP CIRCUIT
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
DC
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D2- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
D2-
Go to step 4
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111719E01
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Spiral Cable
FE
DC
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
DLC3
CG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1183/22
TC
H042144E02
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1183/22 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1183/22 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–258
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
4
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Connector “C”
A36
D2C110388E32
OK
RS
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-4 (D2+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A36-3 (D2-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
D2+
C
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–259
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
Instrument Panel Wire
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D2- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
Connector E
D2-
D2+
Color: Black
C
C111718E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–260
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1185/57
Short in Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the
front passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1185/57 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the front passenger side squib 2nd step
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1185/57
•
•
Short circuit between P2+ wire harness and P2wire harness of front passenger side squib 2nd step
Passenger side squib 2nd step malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
A35
Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step
3
8
A32 P2+
RS
4
7
A32 P2-
C128524E27
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–261
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB
2ND STEP)
D C
Front Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1185/57
TC
C111759E03
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib 2nd step) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1185/57 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1185/57 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS
RS–262
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP
CIRCUIT)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-3 (P2+) - A35-4 (P2)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
Connector “C”
NG
A35
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
P2-
P2+
C
C114767E17
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
DC
Front Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1185/57
TC
C111695E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1185/57 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1185/57 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–263
Open in Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
B1186/58
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the
front passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1186/58 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the front passenger side squib 2nd step
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1186/58
•
•
Open circuit in P2+ wire harness or P2- wire
harness of front passenger side squib 2nd step
Front passenger side squib 2nd step malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-257.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–264
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB
2ND STEP)
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1186/58
TC
C114764E03
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the Instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib 2nd step) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1186/58 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1186/58 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS–265
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP
CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-3 (P2+) - A35-4 (P2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Connector “C”
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
A35
P2-
P2+
C
C114767E17
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1186/58
TC
C111697E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1186/58 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1186/58 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–266
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side Squib
2nd Step Circuit
B1187/55
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the
front passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1187/55 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the front passenger side squib 2nd step
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1187/55
•
•
Short circuit in front passenger side squib 2nd step
wire harness (to ground)
Front passenger side squib 2nd step malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-257.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB
2ND STEP)
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
RS–267
DTC B1187/55
TC
C114765E02
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib 2nd step) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1187/55 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1187/55 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS
RS–268
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP
CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-3 (P2+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A35-4 (P2-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
Connector “C”
NG
A35
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
P2-
P2+
C
C114767E17
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
DC
Front Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1187/55
TC
C111699E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1187/55 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1187/55 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–269
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd
Step Circuit
B1188/56
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly and the
front passenger airbag assembly.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1188/56 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the front passenger side squib 2nd step
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1188/56
•
•
Short circuit in front passenger side squib 2nd step
wire harness (to B+)
Front passenger side squib 2nd step malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front passenger airbag assembly (Front passenger
side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-257.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–270
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB
2ND STEP)
D C
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
SST
DLC3
CG
C
DTC B1188/56
TC
C114766E02
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag assembly.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the front passenger airbag
assembly (front passenger side squib 2nd step) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1188/56 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1188/56 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
RS–271
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP
CIRCUIT)
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
B
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd
Step
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “C”
A35
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A35-3 (P2+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A35-4 (P2-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
P2-
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
P2+
C
C114767E17
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DC
Front Passenger Side
Squib 2nd Step
DLC3
CG
C
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B1188/56
TC
C111701E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the front passenger airbag
assembly and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1188/56 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1188/56 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–272
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–273
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1628/29 Roll Over Cut Off Indicator Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The RSCA OFF switch is a mechanism that operates both right and left side of the curtain shield airbag
assembly and the front seat outer belt assembly when the center airbag sensor assembly detects a rollover.
The RSCA OFF indicator is installed in the combination meter assembly.
If the RSCA OFF switch is operated, the indicator comes on to inform the driver that the roll-over detection
system is not working.
The initial setting of the roll-over detection system is on. It automatically operates every time the ignition
switch is turned on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1628/29
•
•
The center airbag sensor assembly receives an
open signal or short to ground in the RSCA OFF
indicator circuit.
RSCA OFF indicator malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Combination meter assembly (RSCA OFF
indicator)
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Combination Meter Assembly
15
C10
10
C8
6
A32 RMIL
RSCA OFF
Driver Side J/B
GAUGE
4
1G
I18
Ignition SW
6
1D
RS
6 IG2
AM2 7
Engine Room R/B
AM2
2
1
2
2
Battery
H046338E01
RS–274
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RSCA OFF INDICATOR CONDITION
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and push the
RSCA OFF switch for 2 seconds.
(b) Check the RSCA OFF indicator condition according to
the table below.
Result
Proceed to
Condition
A
RSCA OFF indicator dose not come on (remains off) when the RSCA OFF
switch is operated.
B
RSCA OFF indicator remains on when the RSCA OFF switch is not operated.
B
Go to step 6
A
2
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (SOURCE VOLTAGE)
Combination Meter Assembly:
C8
H044462E01
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Remove the combination meter assembly (See page
ME-59).
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C8-10 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
RS–275
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Side:
RMIL
A32
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-6 (RMIL) - C8-10
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
C8-10
C123782E01
OK
4
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C8-10
I033110E02
OK
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C8-10 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–276
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Airbag Sensor
Assembly Center
Combination Meter
Assembly
DTC B1628/29
DLC3
CG
TC
A133750E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(d) Install the combination meter assembly (See page ME61).
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B1628/29 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1628/29 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
If the DTC B1628/29 is output after the center airbag
sensor assembly is replaced, there may be trouble in the
combination meter assembly (RSCA OFF indicator).
If RSCA OFF indicator remains off when DTC B1628/29
is output, there may be trouble in the combination meter
assembly (RSCA OFF indicator).
NG
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
6
CHECK RSCA OFF INDICATOR OPERATION
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the RSCA OFF indicator condition.
OK:
The RSCA OFF indicator does not come on.
RS–277
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
NG
7
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C8-10
I033110E02
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Remove the combination meter assembly (See page
ME-59).
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C8-10 - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–278
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
SRS Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter assembly.
When the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light comes on for approximately 6 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned from the LOCK position to ON position, and then goes off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light comes on to inform the driver of a problem.
When terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 are connected, the DTC is displayed by blinking of the SRS
warning light.
The SRS is equipped with a voltage-increase circuit (DC-DC converter) in the center airbag sensor
assembly in case the source voltage drops.
When the battery voltage drops, the voltage-increase circuit (DC-DC converter) functions to increase the
voltage of the SRS to normal voltage.
A malfunction in this circuit is not recorded in the center airbag sensor assembly. The SRS warning light
automatically goes off when the source voltage returns to normal.
The signal to illuminate the SRS warning light is transmitted from the center airbag sensor assembly to
the combination meter assembly through the multiplex communication system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Combination Meter Assembly
3
2
C10
RS
15
C10
A32 LA
GAUGE
SRS
5
A32 IG2
I18
Ignition Switch
27
A32 E1
13
C10
AM2
28
A32 E2
Battery
C123761E01
RS–279
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT OPERATION
(a) Check the SRS warning light operation approximately 6
seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position.
Result
SRS Warning Light Illumination
Proceed to
Remains on after it goes off
A
Remains on
B
B
Go to step 6
A
2
CHECK BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the battery.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE BATTERY OR
CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connector is properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly.
OK:
The connector is properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–280
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY)
IG2
A32
E2
E1
H040065E25
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Operate all components of the electrical system
(defogger, wipers, headlight, heater blower, etc.).
(e) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-5 (IG2) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-27 (E1) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
A32-28 (E2) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
OK
5
RS
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Check the SRS warning light condition.
OK:
After the primary check period, SRS warning light
goes off for approximately 10 seconds, and
remains on.
HINT:
The primary check period shows approximately 6
seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position.
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
RS–281
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
6
CHECK BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the battery.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE BATTERY OR
CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
7
CHECK CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor assembly and combination meter
assembly.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS
OK
8
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY)
IG2
A32
E2
E1
H040065E25
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Operate all components of the electrical system
(defogger, wipers, headlight, heater blower, etc.).
(e) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-5 (IG2) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-27 (E1) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
A32-28 (E2) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
RS
RS–282
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
9
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE OF COMBINATION METER)
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C10-15
C10-13
I033110E03
(a) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(b) Remove the combination meter assembly (See page
ME-59).
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-15 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-13 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
RS
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
10
RS–283
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OPEN)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Side:
A32
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-3 (LA) - C10-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
LA
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C10-2
C123782E02
OK
11
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
A32
LA
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-3 (LA) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
H040065E26
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
RS
RS–284
12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHORT TO B+)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
A32
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
LA
A32-3 (LA) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
H040065E26
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
OK
13
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Install the combination meter assembly (See page ME61).
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the SRS warning light condition.
OK:
After the primary check period, SRS warning light
goes off for approximately 10 seconds, and
remains on.
HINT:
The primary check period shows approximately 6
seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position.
RS
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–49
B0100/13 Short in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and the
steering pad. The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met. DTC B0100/13
is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the driver side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0100/13
•
•
•
Short circuit between D+ wire harness and D- wire
harness of driver side squib
Driver side squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
1
2
14
A32 D+
13
A32 D-
RS
A36
Spiral Cable
H001451E47
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
RS–50
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
1
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB)
Driver Side Squib
F E
DC
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
SST
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
DTC B0100/13
TC
C
C110385E02
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib) for measurement, as this may lead to a
serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting. Insert the SST
straight into the terminals of the connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0100/13 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) from the spiral
cable.
(d) Check that the spiral cable connector (on the steering
pad side) is not damaged.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–51
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, and the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
OK
3
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "B" (See page RS-28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Driver Side Squib
A
F E
DC
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
D-
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 5
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110386E02
OK
RS
4
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Driver Side Squib
FE
DC
Spiral Cable
DLC3
C
CG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0100/13
TC
C110387E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
RS–52
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
5
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
(a) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
spiral cable.
HINT:
The activation prevention mechanism of connector "B"
has already been released.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-1 (D+) - A36-2 (D-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
A36
D+
DC
RS
C110388E31
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
6
RS–53
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector "D" (See page RS-28).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
1 MΩ or higher
F E
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
Connector E
D-
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110389E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–285
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
SRS Warning Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
See page RS-275.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-275.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the battery.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE BATTERY OR
CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connector is properly connected to the
combination meter assembly.
OK:
The connector is properly connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE OF COMBINATION METER)
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C10-15
C10-13
I033110E03
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Remove the combination meter assembly (See page
ME-59).
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-15 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
RS–286
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(h) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard Resistance:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-13 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
4
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the combination meter
assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the SRS warning light condition.
OK:
After the primary check period, SRS warning light
goes off for approximately 10 seconds, and
remains on.
HINT:
The primary check period is approximately 6 seconds
after the ignition switch is turned to the ON position.
NG
OK
RS
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–287
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
DTC output mode is set by connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
DTCs are displayed by blinking the SRS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Center J/B
23
TC E8
A
J30
J/C
C
3C
E
J29
C
3C
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
Suspension Control ECU
6
TC S15
J/C
A
J30
12
TC T16
19
A32 TC
C
3C
5
IC5
H
J18
(*1)
H
J18
H
J18
D1
DLC3
13
TC
J22 J/C
(*1)
E
E
4
CG
A
J5
J/C
IG
*1: 2UZ-FE
H046343E01
HINT:
When each warning light keeps blinking, a ground short in the wiring of terminal TC of the DLC3 or an
internal ground short in each ECU is suspected.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TC OF DLC3 - TC OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the center airbag sensor assembly
connector.
RS
RS–288
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
DLC3:
D1
1
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D1-13 (TC) - A32-19 (TC)
Always
Below 1 Ω
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
NG
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS (TC
OF DLC3 - TC OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY)
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly:
A32
TC
C123708E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CG OF DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
DLC3:
CG
1
RS
D1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS (CG
OF DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
C128572E06
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TC OF CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
A32
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A32-19 (TC) - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
TC
H040065E27
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS OR
EACH ECU
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–289
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–411
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
RS
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C
C131317E01
RS–412
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the curtain shield airbag assembly installed on
the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are any
defects as mentioned below, replace the front pillar
garnish or roof headlining assembly with a new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
front pillar garnish or roof headlining assembly
around the curtain shield airbag assembly.
2.
H042169
H041659
RS
INSPECT CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
HAS NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the curtain shield airbag assembly removed
from the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are
any defects as mentioned below, replace the curtain
shield airbag assembly with a new one:
• Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on
the curtain shield airbag assembly.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–289
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly RH (Buckle Switch RH)
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH
Occupant Classification
ECU
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
C
Air conditioning Control Assembly (Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator)
C110375E04
RS
RS–290
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
DESCRIPTION OF OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
SYSTEM
(a) GENERAL DESCRIPTION.
(1) In the occupant classification system, the
occupant classification ECU calculates the
weight of the occupant based on a signal from
the occupant classification sensors. This system
recognizes the occupant to be a child if it detects
a weight of less than 36 kg (79.37 lb), and
disables the front passenger airbag assembly
and side airbag (front passenger side).
(2) This system is mainly comprised of 4 occupant
classification sensors that detect the load on the
front passenger seat. The occupant
classification ECU controls the system, and the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator indicates
the ON/OFF condition of the front passenger
airbag and side airbag (front passenger side).
(b) OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR.
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH
RS
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
Occupant Classification ECU
Occupant Load
A
Occupant Classification Sensor
A
A - A Cross Section
C
C110537E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–291
(1) The occupant classification sensors are installed
on 4 brackets connecting the seat rail and seat
frame. Accordingly, when load is applied to the
front passenger seat by an occupant sitting in it,
the occupant classification sensors register a
distortion.
H045951
(c) DESCRIPTION FOR PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/
OFF INDICATOR.
(1) The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator is
installed on the air conditioning control
assembly. This indicator informs the driver
whether the occupant classification ECU puts
the front passenger airbag assembly and side
airbag (front passenger side) into an active state
or inactive state.
(2) If a malfunction occurs in the occupant
classification system, "OFF" indication of the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator and the
SRS warning light will come on.
RS
RS–292
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
The intelligent tester can be used in steps 4, 6, 8 and 9.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CHECK
NEXT
4
DTCs CHECK (Present and Past DTCs)
(a) Check for DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output.
A
DTC is not output.
B
B
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
RS
5
DTCs CHART
NEXT
6
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
7
REPAIR
NEXT
8
CLEAR DTCs (Present and Past DTCs)
(a) Clear DTCs.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–293
NEXT
9
DTCs CHECK (Present and Past DTCs)
(a) Check for DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output.
A
DTC is output.
B
B
Go to step 5
A
10
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
(a) Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator is operating normally.
A
Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator ("OFF") and SRS warning
light come on.
B
B
Go to step 5
A
11
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
RS
RS–294
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
INITIALIZATION
1.
ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
NOTICE:
Make sure that the front passenger seat is not
occupied before performing the operation.
HINT:
Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check if
any of the following conditions occur.
• The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
• Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.) are
installed.
• The front passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
• The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator ("OFF")
comes on when the front passenger seat is not
occupied.
• The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due
to an accident or a collision.
(a) Zero point calibration and sensitivity check
procedures
HINT:
Make sure that zero point calibration has finished
normally, and then perform the sensitivity check.
(1) Adjust the seat position according to the table
below.
Intelligent Tester
A066288E01
Adjustment Component
Position
Slide Direction
Rearmost position
Reclining Angle
Upright position
Headrest Height
Lowest position
Lifter Height
Lowest position
(2) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–295
(4) Perform the zero point calibration by following
the prompts on the tester screen.
ZERO POINT CALIBRATION PROCEDURE
“1: DIAGNOSIS” - ”1: OBD/MOBD” - “MODEL YEAR” - “MODEL SELECTION” - “4 RUNNER” - Select the
option parts” - “9: OCCUPANT DETECT” Refer to the following screen flow.
Refer to the following screen flow.
Perform sensitity check.
Perform DTC check up repair.
RS
Sensor information is
expressed as OK, MAX. or MIN.
in [
].
If MAX. or MIN. is displayed,,
replace the front seat outer belt
assembly.
C
C113452E23
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
RS–296
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
OK:
"COMPLETE" is displayed.
Perform the sensitivity check by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
Confirm that the beginning sensor reading is
within the standard range.
Standard value:
-3.2 to 3.2 kg (-7 to 7 lb)
Place a 30 kg (66.14 lb) weight (eg. a 30 kg
(66.14 lb) of lead mass) onto the front passenger
seat.
Confirm that the sensitivity is within the standard
range.
SENSITIVITY CHECK PROCEDURE
“1: DIAGNOSIS” - “1: OBD/MOBD” - “MODEL YEAR” - “MODEL SELECTION = 4 RUNNER” - Select the
option parts - “9: OCCUPANT DETECT” - Refer to the following screen flow.
RS
*1: kg = lb
Unit can be changed based on unit conversion setting.
[System Selection Screen]
“1: DIAGNOSIS” - “9: SETUP” - “4: UNIT CONVERSION”
- “WEIGHT” (kg = lbs)
C
C113453E21
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
HINT:
• When performing the sensitivity check, use a
solid metal weight (the check result may not
appear properly if a liquid weight is used).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–297
• If the sensitivity deviates from the standard
range, retighten the bolts of the front
passenger seat taking care not to deform the
seat rail. After performing this procedure, if
the sensitivity is not within the standard
range, replace the front seat assembly RH.
• If zero point calibration has not finished
normally, replace the front seat assembly RH.
RS
RS–298
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Proceed to the troubleshooting for each circuit in the table
below.
Occupant Classification System
Symptom
The front passenger seat condition differs from the
indication by the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
(DTC is not output).
RS
Suspected area
Trouble in Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
See page
RS-382
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–299
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
O4
O3
6 54 3 21
121110 9 8 7
6 54 3 21
121110 9 8 7
C
C110373E04
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
+B (O3-1) - GND (O6-3)
R - W-B
Power source (ECU-B
Fuse)
DIA (O3-2) - GND (O6-3)
V - W-B
Diagnosis (DLC3)
IG switch ON
GND (O3-3) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
FSR- (O3-4) - GND (O3-3)
B - W-B
Center airbag sensor
assembly communication
line (-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
BGND (O3-5) - GND (O33)
GR - W-B
Passenger side buckle
switch ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
IG (O3-7) - GND (O3-3)
BR - W-B
Power source (IG2 Fuse)
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
FSR+ (O3-8) - FSR- (O34)
W-B
Center airbag sensor
assembly communication
line
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
BSW (O3-9) - BGND (O35)
L - GR
Passenger side buckle
switch line
Buckle switch ON
Buckle switch OFF
Pulse generation
SGD1 (O4-1) - GND (O33)
G - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor front LH ground
line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD2 (O4-2) - GND (O33)
O - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor front RH ground
line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD3 (O4-3) - GND (O33)
W - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD4 (O4-4) - GND (O33)
BR - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor rear RH ground
line
Always
Below 1 Ω
GR - W
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH power
supply line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor rear
LH
4.5 to 5.1 V
V - BR
Occupant classification
sensor rear RH power
supply line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor rear
RH
4.5 to 5.1 V
BR - G
Occupant classification
sensor front LH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor front
LH
0.2 to 4.7 V
L-O
Occupant classification
sensor front RH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor front
RH
0.2 to 4.7 V
SVC3 (O4-5) - SGD3 (O43)
SVC4 (O4-6) - SGD4 (O44)
SIG1 (O4-7) - SGD1 (O41)
SIG2 (O4-8) - SGD2 (O42)
Always
10 to 14 V
Pulse generation
RS
RS–300
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SIG3 (O4-9) - SGD3 (O43)
SIG4 (O4-10) - SGD4 (O44)
SVC1 (O4-11) - SGD1
(O4-1)
SVC2 (O4-12) - SGD2
(O4-2)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
Y-W
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor rear
LH
B - BR
Occupant classification
sensor rear RH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor rear
RH
0.2 to 4.7 V
R-G
Occupant classification
sensor front LH power
supply line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor front
LH
4.5 to 5.1 V
W-O
Occupant classification
sensor front RH power
supply line
IG switch ON, a load is
applied to occupant
classification sensor front
RH
4.5 to 5.1 V
0.2 to 4.7 V
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG SG
1.
SIL
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECM uses ISO 15765-4 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
H100769E98
Symbols (Terminal No.)
RS
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
HINT:
If the display shows a communication error
message when connecting the cable of the
intelligent tester to the DLC3, turning the ignition
switch to the ON position and operating the
intelligent tester, there is a problem on the vehicle
side or tool side.
• If communication is normal when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
2.
Vibrate Slightly
Shake Slightly
Vibrate Slightly
D025083E03
3.
RS–301
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no
symptoms occur. In such cases, a thorough customer
problem analysis must be carried out. Then the same or
similar conditions and environment in which the problem
occurred in the customer's vehicle should be simulated.
No matter how experienced or skilled a technician may
be, if he proceeds to troubleshoot without confirming the
problem symptoms, he will likely overlook something
important and make a wrong guess at some points in the
repair operation.
This leads to a standstill in troubleshooting.
(a) Vibration method: When vibration seems to be the
major cause.
HINT:
Perform the simulation method only during the
primary check period (for approximately 6 seconds
after the ignition switch is turned to the ON position).
(1) Slightly vibrate the part of the sensor considered
to be the problem cause with your fingers and
check whether the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Shaking the relays too strongly may result in
open relays.
(2) Slightly shake the connector vertically and
horizontally.
(3) Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and
horizontally.
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration
are the major areas to be checked thoroughly.
(b) Simulation method for DTC B1795: Turn the ignition
switch from the LOCK to the ON position, hold for
10 seconds, and then back to the LOCK position
again 50 times in a row.
HINT:
DTC B1795 is output if the occupant classification
ECU receives the ignition switch LOCK-ON-LOCK
signal 50 times in a row when a malfunction occurs
in the power circuit for the occupant classification
system.
FUNCTION OF PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
INDICATOR
(a) Initial check
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator ("ON"
and "OFF") comes on for approximately 4
seconds, then goes off for approximately 2
seconds.
RS
RS–302
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(3) Approximately 6 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position, the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator will be ON/
OFF depending on the conditions listed below.
Condition
ON Indicator
OFF Indicator
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Adult is seated.
ON
OFF
Child is seated.
OFF
ON
Child restraint system is set.
OFF
ON
Front passenger occupant classification
system failure
OFF
ON
HINT:
• The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
comes on based on the timing chart below in
order to check the indicator light circuit.
ON
Ignition Switch
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
(”ON”)
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
(”OFF”)
4 Sec.
2 Sec.
4 Sec.
2 Sec.
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON/OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
RS
H043700E02
• When the occupant classification system has
trouble, both the SRS warning light and the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator ("OFF")
come on. In this case, check the DTCs in the
"AIRBAG SYSTEM" first.
4.
H045951
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
("ON" and "OFF") comes on for approximately 4
seconds, then goes off for approximately 2 seconds.
HINT:
Refer to the table in the previous step regarding the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator when the
ignition switch is turned to the ON position and
approximately 6 seconds have elapsed.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–303
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
Intelligent Tester
A066288E01
DTC CHECK
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of
troubleshooting for "AIRBAG SYSTEM", perform
troubleshooting for the occupant classification system.
(a) Check the DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Check the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
(b) Clear the DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
RS
RS–304
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
By accessing the DATA LIST displayed by the intelligent
tester, you can perform such functions as reading the values
of switches and sensors without removing any parts. Reading
the DATA LIST as the first step in troubleshooting is one
method to shorten labor time.
1.
Intelligent Tester
DATA LIST FOR OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Following the display on the tester screen, read the
"DATA LIST".
A066288E01
Item
RS
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON/OFF
-
IG SW
Ignition switch condition/
ON: Ignition switch ON
OFF: Ignition switch OFF
P BUCKLE SW
Buckle switch (Passenger side)/
UNSET: Unfasten the passenger
side seat belt
SET: Fasten the passenger side
seat belt
NG: Passenger side seat belt has
trouble
UNSET/SET
-
PASSENGER CLASS
Passenger classification/
AM50: Adult more than 54 kg
(119.05 lb) is seated
AF05: Adult (36 to 54 kg (79.37 to
119.05 lb)) is seated
CHILD: Child (less than 36 kg
(79.37 lb)) is seated
CRS: Child restraint system (less
than 7 kg (15.43 lb)) and
passenger side buckle switch is
ON, then 7 to 36 kg (15.43 to
79.37 lb) is set
OFF: Vacant
AM50/AF05/CHILD/CRS/OFF
-
SENS RANGE INF
Sensor range information/
OK: The value of a sensor is
within the range
NG: The value of a sensor is over
the range
OK
-
FL SENS RANGE
Front left sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 27 kg (59.52 lb)
OK
-
FR SENS RANGE
Front right sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 27 kg (59.52 lb)
OK
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–305
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
RL SENS RANGE
Rear left sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 37 kg (81.57 lb)
OK
-
RR SENS RANGE
Rear right sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 37 kg (81.57 lb)
OK
-
FL SENS VOL
Front left sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
FR SENS VOL
Front right sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
RL SENS VOL
Rear left sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
RR SENS VOL
Rear right sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
FL SENS WEIGHT
Front left sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 27 kg (59.52 lb)
-17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
-
FR SENS WEIGHT
Front right sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 27 kg (59.52 lb)
-17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
-
RL SENS WEIGHT
Rear left sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 37 kg (81.57 lb)
-17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
-
RR SENS WEIGHT
Rear right sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 37 kg (81.57 lb)
-17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
-
TOTAL WEIGHT
Total weight information/
Min.: -68 kg (-149.91 lb)
Max.: 128 kg (282.19 lb)
-68 to 128 kg
(-149.91 to 282.19 lb)
-
#PRESENT CODES
Number of present trouble codes/
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
-
#CODES
Number of DTC recorded/
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
-
Item
RS
RS–306
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the circuit listed for the code in the table
below (proceed to the page listed for that circuit).
Occupant Classification ECU
DTC No.
RS
Trouble Area
See page
B1771
Passenger Side Buckle Switch
Circuit Malfunction
Detection Item
1. Front seat inner belt assembly
(Buckle switch RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-305
B1780
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat assembly RH (Front
occupant classification sensor
LH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-311
B1781
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat assembly RH (Front
occupant classification sensor
RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-318
B1782
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat assembly RH (Rear
occupant classification sensor
LH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-325
B1783
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat assembly RH (Front
occupant classification sensor
RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-332
B1785
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH (Front
occupant classification sensor
LH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-339
B1786
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH (Front
occupant classification sensor
RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-343
B1787
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH (Rear
occupant classification sensor
LH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-347
B1788
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH (Rear
occupant classification sensor
RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-351
B1793
Occupant Classification Sensor
Power Supply Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat assembly RH
(Occupant classification sensors)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-366
B1794
Open in Occupant Classification
ECU Battery Positive Line
1. Battery
2. ECU-B Fuse
3. Seat wire No. 1
4. Occupant classification system
RS-373
B1790
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Communication Circuit
Malfunction
1. Occupant classification ECU
2. Center airbag sensor assembly
3. Floor wire
4. Seat wire No. 1
RS-355
B1795
Occupant Classification ECU
Malfunction
1. Front seat inner belt assembly
RH (Buckle switch RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Seat wire No. 1
RS-377
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
B1796
Detection Item
Sleep Operation Failure of
Occupant Classification ECU
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU
RS–307
See page
RS-380
RS
RS–308
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Passenger Side Buckle Switch Circuit Malfunction
B1771
DESCRIPTION
The passenger side buckle switch circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the front seat
inner belt assembly RH.
DTC B1771 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the passenger side buckle switch circuit.
Troubleshoot DTC B1771 first when DTCs B1771 and B1795 are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
B1771
•
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the passenger side buckle switch circuit for 2
seconds.
Passenger side buckle switch malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat inner belt assembly RH (Back switch
RH)
Occupant classification ECU
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
B16
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly RH (Buckle SW RH)
2
9
O3 BSW
1
5
O3 BGND
RS
H046392E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
1
RS–309
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1771 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the front seat inner belt
assembly RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–310
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly RH
Occupant Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the front seat inner belt assembly
RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Connector “B”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-9 (BSW) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O3-5 (BGND) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
O3
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
BGND
BSW
C
C111706E30
OK
4
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
RS
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly RH
Occupant Classification
ECU
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
B17
O3
BGND
1
2
BSW
Service Wire
C
C111707E15
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Using a service wire, connect B17-2 and B17-1 of
connector "C".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-9 (BSW) - O3-5
(BGND)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–311
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "C".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly RH
Occupant Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-9 (BSW) - O3-5
(BGND)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
Connector “B”
O3
BGND
BSW
C
C111706E30
OK
6
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assembly RH
Occupant Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-9 (BSW) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O3-5 (BGND) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “B”
O3
BGND
BSW
C
C111706E30
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–312
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the front seat inner belt assembly RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1771 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
RS
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat inner belt assembly RH (See page
SB-6).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1771 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–313
NG
9
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS293).
NEXT
10
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
11
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
RS
END
RS–54
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0101/14 Open in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and the
steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0101/14 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the driver side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0101/14
•
•
•
Open circuit in D+ wire harness or D- wire harness
of driver side squib
Driver side squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-46.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–55
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB)
DC
F E
Spiral Cable
Driver Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector “E”
SST
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
DTC B0101/14
TC
C
C110390E02
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib) for measurement, as this may lead to a
serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0101/14 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
Go to step 2
RS
RS–56
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Driver Side Squib
A
F E
DC
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
Below 1 Ω
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
NG
Go to step 4
Connector E
D-
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110386E02
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Driver Side Squib
RS
FE
DC
Spiral Cable
DLC3
C
CG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0101/14
TC
C110391E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–57
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-1 (D+) - A36-2 (D-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Driver Side Squib
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
Connector “C”
A36
D+
DC
C110388E31
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
F E
Connector E
D-
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110389E01
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
RS
RS–58
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–314
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
B1780
DESCRIPTION
The front occupant classification sensor LH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
front occupant classification sensor LH.
DTC B1780 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front occupant classification sensor LH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1780
•
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the front occupant classification sensor LH circuit
for 2 seconds.
Front occupant classification sensor LH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH (Front occupant
classification sensor LH)
Occupant classification ECU
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
O5 Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH
SVC1
1
Occupant Classification ECU
11
O4 SVC1
7
SIG1
2
O4 SIG1
RS
SGD1
3
1
O4 SGD1
H043062E20
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
1
RS–315
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1780 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the front occupant
classification sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–316
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
A
D
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the front occupant classification
sensor LH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Connector “B”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-1 (SGD1) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-7 (SIG1) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-11 (SVC1) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4
SGD1
NG
SIG1
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SVC1
C140732E01
OK
4
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
RS
D
A
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Connector “B”
Connector “C”
Service Wire
Occupant
Classification
ECU
O5
SGD1
SVC1
SGD1
SIG1
SIG1
C
O4
SVC1
Service Wire
C111709E23
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O5-1 (SVC1) and O5-3
(SGD1), and connect O5-2 (SIG1) and O5-3 (SGD1) of
connector "C".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-7 (SIG1) - O4-1
(SGD1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-11 (SVC1) - O4-1
(SGD1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–317
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "C".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
A
D
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-7 (SIG1) - O4-1
(SGD1)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-11 (SVC1) - O4-1
(SGD1)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-7 (SIG1) O4-11 (SVC1)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
Connector “B”
O4
SGD1
SIG1
SVC1
C140732E01
OK
6
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
A
D
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-1 (SGD1) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-7 (SIG1) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-11 (SVC1) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “B”
SGD1
SIG1
O4
SVC1
C140732E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–318
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the front occupant classification sensor LH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1780 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
RS
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
10
RS–319
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1780 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
RS
RS–320
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
RS–321
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
B1781
DESCRIPTION
The front occupant classification sensor RH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
front occupant classification sensor RH.
DTC B1781 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front occupant classification sensor RH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1781
•
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the front occupant classification sensor RH circuit
for 2 seconds.
Front occupant classification sensor RH
malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH (Front occupant
classification sensor RH)
Occupant classification ECU
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
O6 Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
SVC2
1
Occupant Classification ECU
12
O4 SVC2
8
SIG2
SGD2
2
3
O4 SIG2
RS
2
O4 SGD2
H043062E52
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
RS–322
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1781 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the front occupant
classification sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
RS
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3
RS–323
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the front occupant classification
sensor RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Connector “B”
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-2 (SGD2) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-8 (SIG2) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-12 (SVC2) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4
SGD2
NG
SIG2
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SVC2
C140732E02
OK
4
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Connector “C”
Service Wire
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Connector “B”
O6
O4
SGD2
SVC2
SGD2
SIG2
SIG2
C
SVC2
Service Wire
C110374E27
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O6-1 (SVC2) and O6-3
(SGD2), and connect O6-2 (SIG2) and O6-3 (SGD2) of
connector "C".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-8 (SIG2) - O4-2
(SGD2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-12 (SVC2) - O4-2
(SGD2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–324
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "C".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-8 (SIG2) - O4-2
(SGD2)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-12 (SVC2) - O4-2
(SGD2)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-8 (SIG2) - O4-12
(SVC2)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
Connector “B”
O4
SGD2
SIG2
SVC2
C140732E02
OK
6
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
RS
D
A
C
B
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-2 (SGD2) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-8 (SIG2) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-12 (SVC2) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “B”
SGD2
SIG2
O4
SVC2
C140732E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
7
RS–325
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the front occupant classification sensor RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1781 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
RS
RS–326
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1781 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
RS
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–327
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–420
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (VEHICLE
NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the front seat side airbag assembly installed on
the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are any
defects as mentioned below, replace the front
seatback assembly with a new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
front seatback assembly around the front seat side
airbag assembly.
2.
H042167
H042168
RS
FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) With the front seat side airbag assembly removed
from the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are
any defects as mentioned below, replace the front
seat side airbag assembly with a new one:
• Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on
the front seat side airbag assembly.
• Cracks or other damage to the wire harness or
connector.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–421
DISPOSAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or
disposing of the front seat side airbag assembly, be sure to
deploy the airbag first in accordance with the procedure
described below. If any abnormality occurs with airbag
deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA
MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a front seat side airbag assembly
that has an undeployed airbag.
• The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the
operation in a place away from electrical noise.
• When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the airbag assembly.
• The front seat side airbag assembly becomes
extremely hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not
touch it for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat side airbag assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat side airbag
assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
1.
SST
C110371E01
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY (WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (See page RS-389).
(b) Precaution (See page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable to prevent the airbag working.
(d) Remove the 4 bolts from the front seat assembly.
• For Manual Seat (See page SE-9)
• For Power Seat (See page SE-18)
HINT:
Keep the front seat assembly in the cabin.
(e) Install the SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector (yellow colored one)
from the front seat side airbag assembly.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take
care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
RS
RS–422
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(2) Connect the SST connector to the front seat
side airbag assembly connector.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00750
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
(3) Install the 4 bolts to the front seat assembly.
• For Manual Seat (See page SE-9)
• For Power Seat (See page SE-18)
Battery
SST
H041665E01
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
C110476E01
(f)
RS
2.
(4) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the vehicle front side window.
(5) Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire
harness in the front side window, close all
doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(6) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The front seat side airbag assembly
becomes extremely hot when the airbag
is deployed, so do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a front seat side airbag
assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat
side airbag assembly with a deployed
airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY (WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the front seat side airbag
assembly, never use the customer's vehicle to
deploy the airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–423
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
SST
C110371E01
Wire Harness Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E02
(a) Check the function of the SST (See page RS-389).
(b) Remove the front seat side airbag assembly.
(1) Remove the front seat assembly.
• For Manual Seat (See page SE-9)
• For Power Seat (See page SE-18)
(2) Remove the 2 nuts and the front seat side
airbag assembly from the seatback assembly.
CAUTION:
• When removing the front seat side airbag
assembly, work must be started 90
seconds after the ignition switch is
turned to the "LOCK" position and the
negative (-) terminal cable is
disconnected from the battery.
• When storing the front seat side airbag
assembly, keep the airbag deployment
side facing upward.
(c) Using a service-purpose wire harness for the
vehicle, tie down the front seat side airbag assembly
to the tire.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative
object is used to tie down the front seat side
airbag assembly, it may be snapped by the
shock when the airbag is deployed. Always use
a wire harness for vehicle use with an area of at
least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
(1) Install the 2 nuts to the front seat side airbag
assembly.
H041666
RS
RS–424
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(2) Wind the wire harness around each of the stud
bolts of the front seat side airbag assembly as
shown in the illustration.
H042339
H042340
RS
Tires
(2 or more)
Tires
(2 or more)
C
C107074E02
(3) Position the front seat side airbag assembly
inside the tire as shown in the illustration.
Tire size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
Width:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
If there is slack in the wire harness, the
front seat side airbag assembly may
become loose due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed.
• Always tie down the front seat side
airbag assembly with the airbag
deployment direction facing inside the
tire.
NOTICE:
The tire will be damaged by airbag
deployment, so use an extra tire.
(d) Install the SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector to the front seat
side airbag assembly connector.
SST 09082-00750
(e) Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire which the
front seat side airbag assembly is tied to.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire which the
front seat side airbag assembly is tied to. The
top tire should have a disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the
tire because it could be damaged.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–425
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
Looseness in the wire harness results in the
tires coming free due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed.
B105087
(f)
Front Seat Side Airbag Assembly
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
C
C107075E02
H000544E01
Install the SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00750
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
tire.
(2) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the airbag tied down to the tires.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius
of the tire which the front seat side airbag
assembly is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
(h) Dispose of the front seat side airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
• The front seat side airbag assembly becomes
extremely hot when the airbag is deployed,
so do not touch it for at least 30 minutes after
deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a front seat side airbag assembly with a
deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat side
airbag assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the front seat side airbag assembly
from the tire.
RS
RS–426
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(2) Place the front seat side airbag assembly in a
plastic bag, tie it tightly and dispose of it as
other general part disposal.
RS
RS–328
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH Circuit
Malfunction
B1782
DESCRIPTION
The rear occupant classification sensor LH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the rear
occupant classification sensor LH.
DTC B1782 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the rear occupant classification sensor LH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1782
•
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the rear occupant classification sensor LH circuit
for 2 seconds.
Rear occupant classification sensor LH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH (Rear occupant
classification sensor LH)
Occupant classification ECU
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
O7 Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
SVC3
1
Occupant Classification ECU
5
O4 SVC3
9
SIG3
2
O4 SIG3
RS
SGD3
3
3
O4 SGD3
H043062E53
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
1
RS–329
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1782 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the rear occupant
classification sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–330
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the rear occupant classification
sensor LH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Connector “B”
O4
SGD3
SVC3
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-3 (SGD3) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-5 (SVC3) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-9 (SIG3) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SIG3
C140732E03
OK
4
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
RS
D
A
C
B
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Connector “C”
Service Wire
Connector “B”
O7
O4
SGD3
SVC3
SVC3
SGD3
SIG3
SIG3
C
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-5 (SVC3) - O4-3
(SGD3)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-9 (SIG3) - O4-3
(SGD3)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Service Wire
C110374E28
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O7-1 (SVC3) and O7-3
(SGD3), and connect O7-2 (SIG3) and O7-3 (SGD3) of
connector "C".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–331
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "C".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-5 (SVC3) - O4-3
(SGD3)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-9 (SIG3) - O4-3
(SGD3)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-5 (SVC3) - O4-9
(SIG3)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
Connector “B”
O4
SGD3
SVC3
SIG3
C140732E03
OK
6
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to value(s) in the table
below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-3 (SGD3) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-5 (SVC3) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-9 (SIG3) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “B”
SGD3
O4
SVC3
SIG3
C140732E03
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–332
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the rear occupant classification sensor LH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1782 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
RS
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
10
RS–333
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1782 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
RS
RS–334
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
RS–335
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
B1783
DESCRIPTION
The rear occupant classification sensor RH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
rear occupant classification sensor RH.
DTC B1783 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the rear occupant classification sensor RH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1783
•
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the rear occupant classification sensor RH circuit
for 2 seconds.
Rear occupant classification sensor RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH (Rear occupant
classification sensor RH)
Occupant classification ECU
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
O8 Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH
SVC4
1
Occupant Classification ECU
6
O4 SVC4
10
SIG4
2
O4 SIG4
RS
SGD4
3
4
O4 SGD4
H043062E54
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
RS–336
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1783 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the rear occupant
classification sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
RS
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3
RS–337
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the rear occupant classification
sensor RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Connector “B”
O4
SGD4
SVC4
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-4 (SGD4) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-6 (SVC4) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-10 (SIG4) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SIG4
C140732E04
OK
4
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Connector “C”
Connector “B”
O8
O4
Service Wire
SGD4
SVC4
SGD4
SIG4
C
SVC4
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-6 (SVC4) - O4-4
(SGD4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-10 (SIG4) - O4-4
(SGD4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
SIG4
Service Wire
C111709E24
OK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O8-1 (SVC4) and O8-3
(SGD4), and connect O8-2 (SIG4) and O8-3 (SGD4) of
connector "C".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–338
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "C".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
D
A
C
B
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-6 (SVC4) - O4-4
(SGD4)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-10 (SIG4) - O4-4
(SGD4)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-6 (SVC4) - O4-10
(SIG4)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
Connector “B”
O4
SGD4
SVC4
SIG4
C140732E04
OK
6
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
RS
D
A
C
B
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-4 (SGD4) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-6 (SVC4) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-10 (SIG4) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “B”
SGD4
O4
SVC4
SIG4
C140732E04
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
7
RS–339
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the rear occupant classification sensor RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1783 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
RS
RS–340
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1783 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
RS
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–341
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–342
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH Collision Detection
B1785
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1785 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the front occupant classification sensor LH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1785 is also output when the front seat assembly RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an
actual accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1785 can be cleared by "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
Therefore, if DTC B1785 is output, first perform "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
DTC No.
B1785
DTC Detecting Condition
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Front occupant classification sensor LH detected a
large load
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat assembly RH (Front occupant
classification sensor LH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-311.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
RS
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–343
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1785 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1785 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
OK
Go to step 8
RS
RS–344
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1785 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1785 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
NEXT
RS
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–345
NEXT
END
RS
RS–346
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH Collision Detection
B1786
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1786 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the front occupant classification sensor RH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1786 is also output when the front seat assembly RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an
actual accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1786 can be cleared by "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
Therefore, if DTC B1786 is output, first perform "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
DTC No.
B1786
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Front occupant classification sensor RH detected a
large load
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat assembly RH (Front occupant
classification sensor RH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-318.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
RS
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–347
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1786 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1786 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
OK
Go to step 8
RS
RS–348
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1786 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1786 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
NEXT
RS
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–349
NEXT
END
RS
RS–350
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH Collision Detection
B1787
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1787 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the rear occupant classification sensor LH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1787 is also output when the front seat assembly RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an
actual accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1787 can be cleared by "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
Therefore, if DTC B1787 is output, first perform "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
DTC No.
B1787
DTC Detecting Condition
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Rear occupant classification sensor LH detected a
large load
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat assembly RH (Rear occupant
classification sensor LH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-325.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
RS
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–351
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1787 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1787 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
OK
Go to step 8
RS
RS–352
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1787 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1787 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
NEXT
RS
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–353
NEXT
END
RS
RS–354
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH Collision Detection
B1788
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1788 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the rear occupant classification sensor RH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1788 is also output when the front seat assembly RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an
actual accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1788 can be cleared by "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
Therefore, if DTC B1788 is output, first perform "Zero point calibration" and "Sensitivity check".
DTC No.
B1788
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Rear occupant classification sensor RH detected a
large load
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat assembly RH (Rear occupant
classification sensor RH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-332.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
RS
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–355
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1788 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1788 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
OK
Go to step 8
RS
RS–356
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1788 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1788 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
NEXT
RS
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–357
NEXT
END
RS
RS–358
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1790
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor assembly communication circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and
the center airbag sensor assembly.
DTC B1790 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the center airbag sensor assembly
communication circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1790
•
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the center airbag sensor assembly
communication circuit for 2 seconds.
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Center airbag sensor assembly
Floor wire
Seat wire No. 1
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
8
FSR+ O3
1
Bl1
3
1
A33 A34 FSR+
(*1) (*2)
4
O3
4
Bl1
2 10
A33 A34 FSR(*1) (*2)
RS
FSR-
*1: with Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
C116312E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–359
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1790 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the center airbag
sensor assembly.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
RS
RS–360
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT TO B+)
F
A
E
DC
Occupant
Classification
ECU
B Center Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O3-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Connector “E”
NG
O3
FSR-
FSR+
C
C110462E30
OK
RS
Go to step 12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
4
RS–361
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (OPEN)
A
E D C B Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Occupant Classification
ECU
Connector “B”
F
A33 (*1)
Connector “E”
FSR-
O3
Service
Wire
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
FSRFSR+
FSR+
A34 (*2)
FSR+
*1: with Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - O3-4
(FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
*2: without Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
FSRC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) with Side and curtain shield airbag:
Using a service wire, connect A33-1 (FSR+) and A33-2
(FSR-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(d) without Side and curtain shield airbag:
Using a service wire, connect A34-3 (FSR+) and A34-10
(FSR-) of connector "B".
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Go to step 13
Service Wire
C111721E12
OK
RS
RS–362
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
F
A
E
DC
Occupant
Classification
ECU
B Center Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - O3-4
(FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 14
Connector “E”
O3
FSR-
FSR+
C
C110462E30
OK
6
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
RS
F
A
E
DC
Occupant
Classification
ECU
B Center Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-8 (FSR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O3-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “E”
O3
FSR-
FSR+
C
C110462E30
OK
Go to step 15
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
7
RS–363
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1790 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
NEXT
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
RS
RS–364
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
11
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1790 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
RS
END
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
12
RS–365
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO B+)
Seat Wire No. 1
F
A
E
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Floor Wire
Connector “C”
Bl1
FSR+
Condition
Specified condition
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
Bl1-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
FSRC
Tester connection
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Body
ground
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
C110464E19
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–366
13
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Seat Wire No. 1
Floor Wire
F
A
E
D C
B
Occupant Classification
ECU
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
(a) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
HINT:
The service wire has already been inserted into the
connector "B".
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Connector “B”
A33 (*1)
Connector “C”
FSR+
Bl1
FSR+
A34 (*2)
FSR+
FSR*1: with Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: without Side and
Curtain Shield Airbag
FSRC
Service Wire
C111722E08
OK
RS
Condition
Specified condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Service
Wire
FSR-
Tester connection
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Bl1-4
(FSR-)
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
14
RS–367
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
F
A
E
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Bl1-4
(FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Floor Wire
Connector “C”
Bl1
FSR+
FSRC
C110464E19
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–368
15
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT TO GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the floor wire connector from the seat wire
No. 1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Seat Wire No. 1
F
A
E
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Floor Wire
Bl1
FSR+
FSRC110464E19
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
Condition
Specified condition
Bl1-1 (FSR+) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
Bl1-4 (FSR-) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
C
Tester connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1793
RS–369
Occupant Classification Sensor Power Supply
Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification sensor power supply circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and
the occupant classification sensors.
DTC B1793 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor power
supply circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1793
•
The occupant classification ECU receives a line
short circuit signal, an open circuit signal, a short
circuit to ground signal or a short circuit to B+ signal
in the occupant classification sensor power supply
circuit for 2 seconds.
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat assembly RH (Occupant classification
sensors)
Occupant classification ECU
Seat wire No. 1
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1793 of the occupant classification system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
O8
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
Occupant Classification ECU
6
SVC4
1
O4 SVC4
O6
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
12
SVC2
1
RS
O4 SVC2
O7
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
5
SVC3
1
O4 SVC3
O5
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
SVC1
1
11
O4 SVC1
H043061E07
RS–370
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the under surface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1793 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the occupant
classification sensors.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
RS
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO
STEP 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3
RS–371
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO B+)
O4
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the 4 occupant classification
sensors.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
SVC3
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H043111E06
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-5 (SVC3) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-6 (SVC4) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-11 (SVC1) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O4-12 (SVC2) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
OK
4
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT TO GROUND)
O4
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
SVC3
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H043111E07
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-5 (SVC3) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-6 (SVC4) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-11 (SVC1) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-12 (SVC2) - Body
ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
RS
RS–372
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (OPEN)
O4
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
SVC3
SVC4
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-5 (SVC3) - O7-1
(SVC3)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-6 (SVC4) - O8- 1
(SVC4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-11 (SVC1) - O5-1
(SVC1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O4-12 (SVC2) - O6-1
(SVC2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
SVC2
SVC1
H043111E08
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
OK
6
CHECK SEAT WIRE NO. 1 (SHORT)
O4
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
SVC3
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H043111E11
RS
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O4-5 (SVC3) - O4-6
(SVC4)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-6 (SVC4) - O4-11
(SVC1)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-11 (SVC1) - O4-12
(SVC2)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-12 (SVC2) - O4-5
(SVC3)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-12 (SVC2) - O4-6
(SVC4)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
O4-11 (SVC1) - O4-5
(SVC3)
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SEAT WIRE NO. 1
OK
7
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the 4 occupant classification sensors.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–373
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1793 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
OK
Go to step 12
RS
RS–374
11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1793 may be output at this time,
but they are related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the front seat assembly RH (See page SE-9 for
manual seat, SE-18 for power seat).
NEXT
RS
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–375
NEXT
END
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–59
B0102/11 Short to GND in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and the
steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0102/11 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the driver side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0102/11
•
•
•
Short circuit in driver side squib wire harness (to
ground)
Driver side squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-46.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
RS–60
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB)
DC
F E
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Connector “E”
SST
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
DTC B0102/11
TC
C
C110392E02
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib) for measurement, as this may lead to a
serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0102/11 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
Go to step 2
RS–61
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Driver Side Squib
A
F E
DC
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Tester connection
Condition
D+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
D- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Specified condition
Go to step 4
Connector E
D-
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110386E02
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Driver Side Squib
FE
DC
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0102/11
DLC3
C
CG
TC
C110393E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–62
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-1 (D+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
A36-2 (D-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector “C”
A36
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
D+
DC
C110388E31
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
A
F E
D C B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Connector E
D-
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110389E01
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
D- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–63
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
RS–376
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1794
Open in Occupant Classification ECU Battery
Positive Line
DESCRIPTION
This circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the power source circuit (battery, fuse, wire
harness).
DTC B1794 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification ECU or the power
source circuit.
HINT:
When DTC B1794 is output after switching the ignition switch LOCK-ON-LOCK 50 times in a row when a
malfunction occurs in the power circuit for the occupant classification system, the DTC is output again
when a malfunction is detected even once after being cleared, unless the normal system code is input.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B1794
•
The ignition switch is turned from LOCK to ON, hold
for 10 seconds or more, and back to LOCK again
50 times in a row when a malfunction occurs in the
power circuit for the occupant classification system.
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Battery
ECU-B Fuse
Seat wire No. 1
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1794 of the occupant classification system.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–377
WIRING DIAGRAM
I18
Ignition SW
Engine Room R/B
Occupant Classification ECU
AM2
2
1
2
Short Pin
1
2
2
7 AM2
2
Driver Side J/B
ECU-B
2
2
1
IG2 6
6
1D
2
11
1J
IGN
4
1B
4
1L
Center J/B
B
3E
J8
J/C
B
B
B
3E
B J/C B
J31
J32
15
IO3
5
Bl1
1
O3 +B
14
IO3
6
Bl1
7
O3 IG
3
Bl1
3
O3 GND
RS
Battery
BM
H045968E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the battery.
Voltage:
11 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE BATTERY
RS–378
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FUSE
(a) Check the ECU-B fuse.
Resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
GND
O3
+B
IG
H043111E10
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the occupant
classification ECU.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage and resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-1 (+B) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
O3-7 (IG) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
O3-3 (GND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
RS
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
4
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 10 seconds.
(e) Using the intelligent tester, check the DTCs of the
occupant classification ECU (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1794 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1794 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–379
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
5
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
6
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform the "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
The "COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
7
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the "Sensitivity
check" (See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–380
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1795
Occupant Classification ECU Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1795 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification ECU.
Troubleshoot DTC B1771 first when the DTCs B1771 and B1795 are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
•
B1795
•
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU circuit malfunction
The occupant classification ECU receives a short
circuit to ground signal in the passenger side
buckle switch circuit for 2 seconds.
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
•
•
•
Seat wire No. 1
Front seat inner belt assembly RH (Buckle switch
RH)
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1795 of the occupant classification system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-374.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 10 seconds.
(b) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
Result:
A:
DTCs B1771 and B1795 are output.
B:
DTC B1795 is output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1771 and B1795 may be output
at this time, but they are not related to this check.
RS
A
GO TO DTC B1771
B
2
CHECK FUSE
(a) Measure the resistance of the ECU-B fuse.
Resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE FUSE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3
RS–381
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE)
GND
O3
+B
IG
H043111E10
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the occupant
classification ECU.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-1 (+B) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
O3-7 (IG) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O3-3 (GND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
4
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETED" is displayed.
RS
RS–382
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
NEXT
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS–427
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING BRACKET FRONT
17.5 (178, 13)
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
CONSOLE BOX DUCT NO. 1
CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
CONSOLE UPPER
PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
CONSOLE UPPER REAR
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
CONSOLE PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
RS
CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131318E03
RS–428
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
RS
1.
INSPECT CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
2.
INSPECT CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
HAS NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
3.
INSPECT CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
HAS DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the center airbag sensor assembly.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
HINT:
The center airbag sensor assembly should be
replaced after any of the airbags has deployed, as it
has been subjected to the impact.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
RS–383
Sleep Operation Failure of Occupant Classification ECU
B1796
DESCRIPTION
During sleep mode, the occupant classification ECU reads the condition of each sensor while the ignition
switch is off.
In this mode, if the occupant classification ECU detects an internal malfunction, DTC B1796 is output.
DTC No.
B1796
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-300).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position, and wait
for at least 10 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC B1796 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1796 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
NG
2
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
3
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
RS–384
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
The "COMPLETED" is displayed.
NEXT
4
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard values:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–385
Trouble in Passenger Airbag ON / OFF Indicator
DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification system detects the front passenger seat condition. It then informs a
passenger of the front passenger airbag assembly condition (activated/not activated) by the passenger
airbag ON/OFF indicator.
The table below shows the normal indication condition of the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator and the
front passenger seat condition.
Front passenger seat condition
ON Indicator
OFF Indicator
Adult is seated.
ON
OFF
Child is seated.
OFF
ON
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Occupant classification system failure
OFF
ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and check the
SRS warning light condition.
HINT:
If this trouble occurs, the SRS warning light is off. If it is
on, a DTC is output. Troubleshoot for the output DTC.
OK:
The SRS warning light does not come on.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
2
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CONDITION
RS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check if the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
correctly indicates the front passenger seat condition.
OK
Front passenger seat condition
ON Indicator
OFF Indicator
ON
OFF
Adult is seated.
Child is seated.
OFF
ON
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Occupant classification system failure
OFF
ON
OK
END
NG
3
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
RS–386
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETE" is displayed.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
4
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 5
OK
END
5
RETIGHTEN FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH BOLT
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Loosen the 4 installation bolts of the front seat assembly
RH.
(c) Tighten the 4 installation bolts of the front seat assembly
RH to the specified torque.
Torque: 37 N*m (380 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
NG
RS
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETE" is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
7
RS–387
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
8
CHECK CONNECTORS
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Check the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the 4 occupant
classification sensors.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
(d) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the 4 occupant classification
sensors.
(e) Check the connectors are not damaged or deformed.
OK:
The connectors are properly normal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
9
RS
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the 4 occupant classification sensors.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in the memory (See page RS300).
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (See page RS-300).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS–388
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (See page RS447).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
11
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the intelligent tester, perform "Zero point
calibration" (See page RS-293).
OK:
"COMPLETE" is displayed.
NEXT
12
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform "Sensitivity check"
(See page RS-293).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
RS
NEXT
END
RS–388
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1 ).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the steering wheel No.
3 cover lower.
HINT:
Tape up the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the steering wheel No.
2 cover lower.
HINT:
Tape up the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE STEERING PAD
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), loosen the 2
"torx" screws until the groove along the screw
circumference catches on the screw case.
F043322
RS
H042354
(b) Pull out the steering pad from the steering wheel
assembly and support the steering pad with one
hand as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When removing the steering pad, do not pull the
airbag wire harness.
(c) Using a screw driver, disconnect the 2 connectors
from the steering pad.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(d) Remove the steering pad.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
RS–389
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STEERING PAD
(a) Support the steering pad with one hand as shown in
the illustration.
(b) Connect the 2 connectors to the steering pad.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(c) Connect the horn connector.
(d) Confirm that the circumference groove of the "torx"
screw fits in the screw case, and place the steering
pad onto the steering wheel assembly.
(e) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), tighten the 2
"torx" screws.
Torque: 8.8 N*m (90 kgf*cm, 78 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL NO.3 COVER LOWER
(a) Install the steering wheel No.3 cover lower.
3.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL NO.2 COVER LOWER
(a) Install the steering wheel No.2 cover lower.
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
INSPECT STEERING PAD
(a) With the steering pad installed on the vehicle,
perform a visual check. If there are any defects as
mentioned below, replace the steering pad with a
new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
steering pad top surface or in the grooved portion.
(b) Make sure that the horn sounds.
HINT:
If the horn does not sound, inspect the horn system
(See page HO-2).
6.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
H042354
H042163
RS
RS–390
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or
disposing of the steering pad, be sure to deploy the airbag
first in accordance with the procedure described below. If any
abnormality occurs with airbag deployment, contact the
SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a steering pad that has an
undeployed airbag.
• The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the
operation in a place away from electrical noise.
• When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the steering pad.
• The steering pad becomes extremely hot when the
airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
steering pad with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a steering pad with a
deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
1.
DISPOSE OF STEERING PAD (WHEN INSTALLED IN
VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST.
SST 09082-00700
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, always use the
specified SST:
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
RS
SST
C110371E01
Battery
SST
C110372E01
(1) Connect the SST to the battery.
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
SST
C110475E01
H042176
RS–391
(2) Check the function of the SST.
Press the SST activation switch, and check that
the LED of the SST activation switch comes on.
CAUTION:
• Do not connect the SST connector
(yellow colored one) to the airbag.
• If the LED comes on when the activation
switch is not being pressed, SST
malfunction is possible, so replace the
SST with a new one.
(3) Disconnect the SST from the battery.
(b) Precaution (See page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable to prevent the airbag working.
(d) Remove the steering column cover lower.
(1) While turning the steering wheel assembly to
the right and left, remove the 3 screws and
steering column cover lower.
(e) Install the SST.
CAUTION:
Check that there is no looseness in the steering
wheel assembly and steering pad.
(1) Disconnect the airbag connector (yellow
colored one) from the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take
care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) Connect the SST connector to the airbag
connector of the spiral cable.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST
H042347E02
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
C110476E01
(3) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the vehicle front side window.
(4) Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire
harness in the front side window, close all
doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
RS
RS–392
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
(f)
2.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The steering pad becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed, so do not
touch it for at least 30 minutes after
deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a steering pad with a deployed
airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a steering pad
with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
DISPOSE OF STEERING PAD (WHEN NOT
INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the steering pad, never use the
customer's vehicle to deploy the airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST.
SST 09082-00700
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, always use the
specified SST:
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
RS
SST
C110371E01
Battery
SST
C110372E01
(1) Connect the SST to the battery.
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
SST
C110475E01
Wire Harness Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E02
L
M
H042357E02
RS–393
(2) Check the function of the SST.
Press the SST activation switch, and check that
the LED of the SST activation switch comes on.
CAUTION:
• Do not connect the SST connector
(yellow colored one) to the airbag.
• If the LED comes on when the activation
switch is not being pressed, SST
malfunction is possible, so replace the
SST with a new one.
(3) Disconnect the SST from the battery.
(b) Remove the steering pad (See page RS-387).
CAUTION:
• When removing the steering pad, work must
be started 90 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the "LOCK" position and
the negative (-) terminal cable is
disconnected from the battery.
• When storing the steering pad, keep the
airbag deployment side facing upward.
(c) Using a service-purpose wire harness for the
vehicle, tie down the steering pad to the disc wheel.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative
object is used to tie down the steering pad, it
may be snapped by the shock when the airbag
is deployed. Always use a wire harness for
vehicle use with an area of at least 1.25 mm2
(0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
(1) Install the 2 bolts with washers into the 2 bolt
holes on the steering pad.
Bolt:
L:
35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
M:
6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Pitch:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
NOTICE:
• Tighten the bolts by hand until they
become difficult to turn.
• Do not tighten the bolts excessively.
RS
RS–394
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
(2) After connecting the SST below to each other,
connect them to the steering pad.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 0908230801)
SST
H042358E01
(3) Using 3 wire harnesses, wind wire harness at
least 2 times each around each of the bolts
installed on the left and right sides of the
steering pad.
CAUTION:
• Tightly wind the wire harness around the
bolts so that there is no slack.
• Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
If there is slack in the wire harness, the
steering pad may become loose due to
the shock when the airbag is deployed.
2 times or more
H042359E03
RS
H042360
(4) Face the airbag deployment side of the
steering pad upward on top of a tire and wheel
set. Separately tie the left and right sides of the
steering pad to the disc wheel through the hub
nut holes. Position the SST connector so that it
hangs downward through the hub hole of the
disc wheel.
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
If there is slack in the wire harness, the
steering pad may become loose due to
the shock when the airbag is deployed.
• Always tie down the steering pad with
the airbag deployment side facing
upward.
NOTICE:
The disc wheel will be damaged by airbag
deployment, so use an extra disc wheel.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
SST
H042361E02
RS–395
(d) Install the SST.
CAUTION:
Place the disc wheel on level ground.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
disc wheel.
(2) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the airbag tied down to the tire.
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H040014E06
Y
Y
X
Weight
Weight
C111122E01
(e) Cover the steering pad (Using a cardboard box).
(1) Cover the steering pad with the cardboard box.
(2) Place weights on the cardboard box in 4 places
totalling at least 190 N (19 kg, 43 lb).
Cardboard box size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
X:
460 mm (18.11 in.)
Y:
650 mm (25.59 in.)
NOTICE:
• When the dimension Y of the cardboard
box exceeds the diameter of the disc
wheel with tire which the steering pad is
tied to, X should be the following size.
X = 460 mm (18.11 in.) + width of tire
• If a cardboard box which is smaller than
the specified size is used, the cardboard
box will be broken by the shock from
airbag deployment.
RS
RS–396
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
(f)
Inner Diameter
Width
Tires
(3 or more)
C111105E06
Cover the steering pad (Using tires).
(1) Place at least 3 tires without disc wheels on the
tire with disc wheel which the steering pad is
tied to.
(2) Place the tire with a disc wheel on top of them.
Tire size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
Width:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Do not use tires with disc wheels except for
on the top and bottom.
NOTICE:
• The tires may be damaged by airbag
deployment, so use an extra tire.
• Do not place the SST connector under
the tire because it could be damaged.
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
Looseness in the wire harness results in the
tires coming free due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed.
C107322
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
Using a cardboard box:
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
Steering Pad
Using tires:
SST
RS–397
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius
of the disc wheel which the steering pad is tied
to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
Battery
10 m (33 ft) or more
Steering Pad
C111123E01
H040177
(h) Dispose of the steering pad.
CAUTION:
• The steering pad becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch
it for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a steering pad with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a steering pad with
a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the steering pad from the disc wheel.
(2) Place the steering pad in a plastic bag, tie it
tightly and dispose of it as other general part
disposal.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
RS–399
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) If there are any defects as mentioned below, replace
the spiral cable with a new one:
Scratches, cracks, dents or chips on the connector
or the spiral cable.
RS
RS–400
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Check that the front wheels are facing straight
ahead.
(b) Set the turn signal switch to the neutral position.
NOTICE:
If it is not in the neutral position, the pin of the
turn signal switch may snap.
(c) Install the spiral cable with the 4 screws.
NOTICE:
When replacing the spiral cable with a new one,
remove the lock pin before installing the
steering wheel assembly.
(d) Connect the connectors to the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H042178
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER UPPER
(a) Install the steering column cover upper.
3.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER
(a) Install the steering column cover lower with the 3
screws.
4.
ADJUST SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90
seconds before starting the operation.
H042177
(c) Rotate the spiral cable counterclockwise slowly by
hand until it feels firm.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the spiral cable by the airbag wire
harness.
RS
H042179
(d) Rotate the spiral cable clockwise approximately 2.5
turns to align the marks.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the spiral cable by the airbag wire
harness.
HINT:
The spiral cable will rotate approximately 2.5 turns
to both the left and right from the center.
Marks
5.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-21)
6.
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
H042180E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
RS–401
7.
INSTALL STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
8.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
(See page RS-388)
9.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
(See page RS-388)
10. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
11. INSPECT STEERING PAD (See page RS-389)
12. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–403
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
(See page RS-387)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
(See page RS-388)
6.
REMOVE STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
7.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-9)
8.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER (See
page SR-9)
9.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPPER
10. DISCONNECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY CONNECTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector from the passenger
airbag assembly connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H042181
11. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
See page IP-12
12. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY (See
page IP-12)
13. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 2 (See
page IP-12)
14. REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 3 clamps.
C131377
RS
RS–404
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(b) Remove the 3 screws and the front passenger
airbag assembly.
C131378
(c) Release the rear side wall of the airbag door from
the hook by slightly deflecting it and roll the front
passenger airbag assembly forward.
(d) Release the front side wall of the airbag door from
the other hook and remove the front passenger
airbag assembly.
Hook
Hook
Front
Airbag Door
C131326E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front passenger airbag assembly with the
3 screws.
C131378
(b) Install the 3 clamps.
RS
C131377
2.
INSTALL HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO. 2
HINT:
See page IP-13
3.
INSTALL DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
HINT:
See page IP-12
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
See page IP-12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–405
5.
CONNECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR
(a) Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assembly.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
6.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER UPPER (See
page SR-21)
7.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER
HINT:
See page SR-21
8.
ADJUST SPIRAL CABLE (See page RS-399)
9.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-21)
H042181
10. INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
11. INSTALL STEERING PAD (See page RS-389)
12. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2
(See page RS-388)
13. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3
(See page RS-388)
14. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
15. INSPECT STEERING PAD (See page RS-389)
16. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
RS–406
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or
disposing of the front passenger airbag assembly, be sure to
deploy the airbag first in accordance with the procedure
described below. If any abnormality occurs with airbag
deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of the TOYOTA
MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a front passenger airbag assembly
that has an undeployed airbag.
• The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the
operation in a place away from electrical noise.
• When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the front passenger airbag
assembly.
• The front passenger airbag assembly becomes
extremely hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not
touch it for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
1.
RS
SST
C110371E01
DISPOSE OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY (WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (See page RS-389).
(b) Precaution (See page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable to prevent the airbag working.
(d) Remove the instrument panel under cover subassembly No. 2 (See page IP-9).
(e) Remove the glove compartment door assembly
(See page IP-9).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(f)
RS–407
Install the SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the front
passenger airbag assembly.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take
care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H042181
(2) Connect the SST connector to the front
passenger airbag assembly.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST
H041650E02
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
C110476E01
(3) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the vehicle front side window.
(4) Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire
harness in the front side window, close all
doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The front passenger airbag assembly
becomes extremely hot when the airbag
is deployed, so do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a front passenger airbag
assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front
passenger airbag assembly with a
deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
RS
RS–408
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
2.
DISPOSE OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY (WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the front passenger airbag
assembly, never use the customer's vehicle to
deploy the airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (See page RS-389).
SST
C110371E01
RS
C131325
Wire Harness Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E02
(b) Remove the front passenger airbag assembly (See
page RS-402).
CAUTION:
• When removing the front passenger airbag
assembly, work must be started 90 seconds
after the ignition switch is turned to the
"LOCK" position and the negative (-) terminal
cable is disconnected from the battery.
• When storing the front passenger airbag
assembly, keep the airbag deployment side
facing upward.
(c) Using a service-purpose wire harness for the
vehicle, tie down the front passenger airbag
assembly to the tire.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative
object is used to tie down the front passenger
airbag assembly, it may be snapped by the
shock when the airbag is deployed. Always use
a wire harness for vehicle use with an area of at
least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–409
(1) Position the front passenger airbag assembly
inside the tire with the airbag deployment side
facing inside.
Inner Diam.
Width
Tire
C131327E01
Tire size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
Width:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
If there is slack in the wire harness, the
front passenger airbag assembly may
become loose due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed.
• Always tie down the front passenger
airbag assembly with the airbag
deployment side facing inside the tire.
NOTICE:
The tire will be damaged by airbag
deployment, so use an extra tire.
(d) Install the SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector to the front
passenger airbag assembly.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
RS
RS–410
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Tires
(2 or more)
Tires
(2 or more)
(e) Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire which the
front passenger airbag assembly is tied to.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire which the
front passenger airbag assembly is tied to. The
top tire should have a disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the
tire because it could be damaged.
C131328E01
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
Looseness in the wire harness results in the
tires coming free due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed.
B105087
(f)
Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly
Battery
SST
RS
10 m (33 ft) or more
C111107E02
Install the SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
tire.
(2) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the airbag tied down to the tires.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius
of the tire which the front passenger airbag
assembly is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
H041436E03
RS–411
(h) Dispose of the front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
• The front passenger airbag assembly
becomes extremely hot when the airbag is
deployed, so do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a front passenger airbag assembly with a
deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger
airbag assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the front passenger airbag assembly
from the tire.
(2) Place the front passenger airbag assembly in a
plastic bag, tie it tightly and dispose of it as
other general part disposal.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–413
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
NOTICE:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to "REMOVE ROOF
HEADLINING ASSEMBLY" (See page IR-7).
4.
REMOVE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connector from the curtain shield
airbag assembly LH.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Remove the 11 bolts and the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH.
HINT:
Remove the bolts from front side of the vehicle in
order.
RS
H041655
RS–414
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the curtain shield airbag assembly LH with
the 11 bolts.
HINT:
Install the bolts from rear side of the vehicle in order.
H041655
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not twist the curtain shield airbag assembly
LH when installing it.
(b) Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag
assembly LH.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
RS
2.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from "INSTALL ROOF
HEADLINING ASSEMBLY" (See page IR-14).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–415
DISPOSAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or
disposing of the curtain shield airbag assembly, be sure to
deploy the airbag first in accordance with the procedure
described below. If any abnormality occurs with airbag
deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA
MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a curtain shield airbag assembly that
has an undeployed airbag.
• The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the
operation in a place away from electrical noise.
• When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the curtain shield airbag
assembly.
• The curtain shield airbag assembly becomes
extremely hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not
touch it for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
curtain shield airbag assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a curtain shield airbag
assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
1.
SST
C110371E01
DISPOSE OF CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (See page RS-389).
(b) Precaution (See page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable to prevent the airbag working.
(d) Remove the roof headlining assembly.
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to "REMOVE ROOF
HEADLINING ASSEMBLY" (See page IR-7).
(e) Install the SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the curtain
shield airbag assembly.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take
care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
RS
RS–416
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(2) After connecting the SST below to each other,
connect them to the curtain shield airbag
assembly.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00802 (0908210801, 09082-20801)
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST
SST
H041656E01
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
C110501E01
(f)
RS
2.
(3) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the vehicle rear side window.
(4) Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire
harness in the rear side window, close all doors
and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The curtain shield airbag assembly
becomes extremely hot when the airbag
is deployed, so do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a curtain shield airbag
assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a curtain
shield airbag assembly with a deployed
airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
DISPOSE OF CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the curtain shield airbag
assembly, never use the customer's vehicle to
deploy the airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–417
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (See page RS-389).
(b) Remove the curtain shield airbag assembly (See
page RS-412).
CAUTION:
When removing the curtain shield airbag
assembly, work must be started 90 seconds
after the ignition switch is turned to the "LOCK"
position and the negative (-) terminal cable is
disconnected from the battery.
H041657
(c) Remove the bolt from the curtain shield airbag
assembly.
H041658
(d) Cut off the deployment section of the curtain shield
airbag assembly.
RS
H041659
Wire Harness Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E02
(e) Using a service-purpose wire harness for the
vehicle, tie down the curtain shield airbag assembly
to the tire.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative
object is used to tie down the curtain shield
airbag assembly, it may be snapped by the
shock when the airbag is deployed. Always use
a wire harness for vehicle use with an area of at
least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
RS–418
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Width
Inner Diam
H041660E01
Tires
(2 or more)
RS
Tires
(2 or more)
(1) Position the curtain shield airbag assembly
inside the tire as shown in the illustration.
Tire size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
Width:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If
there is slack in the wire harness, the
curtain shield airbag assembly may become
loose due to the shock when the airbag is
deployed.
NOTICE:
The tire will be damaged by airbag
deployment, so use an extra tire.
(f) Install the SST.
(1) After connecting the SST below to each other,
connect them to the curtain shield airbag
assembly.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 0908220801)
(g) Place the tires.
CAUTION:
Do not face the deployment direction of the
curtain shield airbag assembly toward the
ground.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire which the
curtain shield airbag assembly is tied to.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire which the
curtain shield airbag assembly is tied to. The
top tire should have a disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the
tire because it could be damaged.
H041661E01
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
Looseness in the wire harness results in the
tires coming free due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed.
B105087
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Curtain Shield
Airbag Assembly
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
C111112E01
(h) Install the SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00802 (0908210801, 09082-20801)
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
tire.
(2) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the airbag tied down to the tires.
(i) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the
SST to the negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius
of the tire which the curtain shield airbag
assembly is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
(j)
H041663
RS–419
Dispose of the curtain shield airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
• The curtain shield airbag assembly becomes
extremely hot when the airbag is deployed,
so do not touch it for at least 30 minutes after
deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a curtain shield airbag assembly with a
deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a curtain shield
airbag assembly with a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the curtain shield airbag assembly
from the tire.
(2) Place the curtain shield airbag assembly in a
plastic bag, tie it tightly and dispose of it as
other general part disposal.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS–429
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
(See page IP-7)
6.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
7.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR (See
page IP-9)
8.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING BRACKET
FRONT
9.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX DUCT NO. 1 (See page AC113)
10. REMOVE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 3 connectors from the center airbag
sensor assembly.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and the center airbag sensor
assembly.
H042342
RS
RS–430
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
1.
(c) Temporarily install the center airbag sensor
assembly with the 3 bolts.
NOTICE:
• If the center airbag sensor assembly has
been dropped, or there are any cracks, dents
or other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace it with a new one.
• When installing the center airbag sensor
assembly, be careful that the SRS wiring does
not interfere with other parts and that it is not
pinched between other parts.
(d) Tighten the 3 bolts to the specified torque.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (179 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
(e) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the center airbag sensor assembly.
(f) Connect the 3 connectors to the center airbag
sensor assembly.
(g) Check that the waterproof sheet is properly set.
H042342
RS
INSTALL CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the negative battery
terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before
starting the operation.
2.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX DUCT NO. 1
3.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING BRACKET
FRONT
4.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY REAR
5.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 2
6.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH NO. 1
7.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
8.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
9.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
10. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS–64
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B0103/12 Short to B+ in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor assembly, the spiral cable and the
steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0103/12 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the driver side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
•
B0103/12
•
•
•
Short circuit in driver side squib wire harness (to
B+)
Driver side squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Center airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Spiral cable
Center airbag sensor assembly
Instrument panel wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page RS-46.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "check mode" (signal check) with the intelligent tester
(See page RS-38).
• After selecting the "check mode" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (See page RS-38).
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–65
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB)
DC
F E
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Connector “E”
SST
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
DTC B0103/12
TC
C
C110394E02
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the spiral cable.
CAUTION:
Never connect a tester to the steering pad (driver
side squib) for measurement, as this may lead to a
serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert the SST into the terminals of
the connector when connecting.
Insert the SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B0103/12 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
Go to step 2
RS
RS–66
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT
Driver Side Squib
A
F E
DC
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Connector E
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
assembly.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
D-
Go to step 4
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110386E02
OK
3
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Driver Side Squib
RS
FE
DC
Spiral Cable
DLC3
C
CG
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
DTC B0103/12
TC
C110395E01
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the steering pad and the
center airbag sensor assembly.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (See page RS-35).
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(i) Check the DTCs (See page RS-35).
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–67
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
4
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Connector “C”
A36
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
spiral cable.
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A36-1 (D+) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A36-2 (D-) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D+
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
DC
C110388E31
OK
RS
RS–68
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Voltage
Instrument Panel Wire
A
F E
D C B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Driver Side Squib
Connector E
D-
D+
Color: Orange
C
C110389E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
RS
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
RS–432
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the front airbag sensor LH.
A: 65 mm (2.559 in.)
B: 43 mm (1.693 in.)
A
RS
B
C131330E01
(b) Disconnect the connector from the front airbag
sensor LH.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–433
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the negative battery
terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before
starting the operation.
(c) Install the front airbag sensor LH with the 2 bolts.
A: 65 mm (2.559 in.)
B: 43 mm (1.693 in.)
A
B
C131330E01
Torque: Length A 65 mm (2.559 in.)
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
Length B 43 mm (1.693 in.)
9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• If the front airbag sensor LH has been
dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or
other defects in the case or connector,
replace it with a new one.
• When installing the front airbag sensor LH, be
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere
with other parts and that it is not pinched
between other parts.
(d) Connect the connector to the front airbag sensor
LH.
(e) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the front airbag sensor LH.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
RS–430
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
A
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
B
A
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
B
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
A: 65 mm (2.559 in.)
B: 43 mm (1.693 in.)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131319E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–431
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
2.
INSPECT FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) When the front bumper of the vehicle or its area is
damaged, check if there is any damage to the front
airbag sensor. If any of the front airbag sensors
have defects as mentioned below, replace it with a
new one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
• Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial
number.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
3.
INSPECT FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS
DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the front airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
HINT:
The front airbag sensor on the impacted side should
be replaced after the steering pad or front
passenger airbag assembly has deployed.
RS
RS–436
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-9)
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-8)
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
6.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
7.
REMOVE LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER
8.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
9.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
10. REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and the side airbag sensor LH.
(b) Disconnect the connector from the side airbag
sensor LH.
RS
H042349
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–437
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the negative battery
terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before
starting the operation.
(c) Install the side airbag sensor LH with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (179 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• If the side airbag sensor LH has been
dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or
other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace it with a new one.
• When installing the side airbag sensor LH, be
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere
with other parts and that it is not pinched
between other parts.
(d) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the side airbag sensor LH.
(e) Connect the connector to the side airbag sensor LH.
H042349
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
3.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
4.
INSTALL LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-17)
8.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-17)
9.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
10. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
RS–440
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
4.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page SB26)
5.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR (See page SB-26)
6.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
7.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
8.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
9.
REMOVE LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER REAR
NO. 1 SEAT
10. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH
11. REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER LH
12. REMOVE REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Disconnect the connector from the rear airbag
sensor LH.
RS
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and the rear airbag sensor LH.
H042352
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–441
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the negative battery
terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before
starting the operation.
(c) Install the rear airbag sensor LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (179 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
CAUTION:
• If the rear airbag sensor LH has been
dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or
other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace it with a new one.
• When installing the rear airbag sensor LH, be
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere
with other parts and that it is not pinched
between other parts.
(d) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the rear airbag sensor LH.
(e) Connect the connector to the rear airbag sensor LH.
H042352
2.
INSTALL DECK SIDE TRIM COVER LH
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH
4.
INSTALL LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER REAR
NO. 1 SEAT
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
6.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
7.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
8.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
9.
INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
10. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
11. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
12. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
RS–434
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY LH
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR LH
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
42 (420, 31)
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
17.5 (178, 13)
FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
RS
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
LAP BELT OUTER
ANCHOR COVER
42 (420, 31)
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C
C131320E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–435
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
2.
INSPECT SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) When the center pillar of the vehicle or its area is
damaged, check if there is any damage to the side
airbag sensor. If there are any defects as mentioned
below, replace the side airbag sensor with a new
one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
• Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial
number.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
3.
INSPECT SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS
DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the side airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
HINT:
The side airbag sensor on the impacted side should
be replaced after the front seat side airbag
assembly and curtain shield airbag assembly have
deployed.
RS
RS–444
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH (for Manual Seat) (See page SE-9)
4.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH (for Power Seat) (See page SE-18)
5.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH (for Manual Seat) (See page SE-9)
6.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH (for Power Seat)
7.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH (for
Manual Seat) (See page SE-9)
8.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH (for
Power Seat) (See page SE-18)
9.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
(for Manual Seat) (See page SE-9)
10. REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
(for Power Seat) (See page SE-18)
11. REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (for Manual
Seat) (See page SE-9)
RS
12. REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (for Power
Seat) (See page SE-18)
13. REMOVE SEAT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector from the seat position
sensor.
(b) Remove the bolt and seat position sensor.
H042353
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
RS–445
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SEAT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the negative battery (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the negative battery
terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before
starting the operation.
(c) Install the seat position sensor with a new bolt.
Part Number:
Bolt:
90119-06871
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(d) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the seat position sensor.
(e) Connect the connector to the seat position sensor.
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (for Manual
Seat) (See page SE-13)
3.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (for Power
Seat) (See page SE-23)
4.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
(for Manual Seat)
5.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
(for Power Seat)
6.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH (for
Manual Seat)
7.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH (for
Power Seat)
8.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH (for Manual Seat)
9.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH (for Power Seat)
10. INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH (for Manual Seat)
11. INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH (for Power Seat)
12. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
13. INSPECT SLIDE ADJUSTER LOCK (for Manual Seat)
14. INSPECT POWER SEAT OPERATION (for Power
Seat)
15. INSPECT SEAT HEATER OPERATION (w/ Seat Heater
System)
16. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
RS–438
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR
COVER REAR NO. 1 SEAT
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
17.5 (178, 13)
42 (420, 31)
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
RS
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
REAR FLOOR MAT
SUPPORT PLATE REAR
DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C
C131321E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–439
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT REAR AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
2.
INSPECT REAR AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) When the quarter panel of the vehicle or its area is
damaged, check if there is any damage to the rear
airbag sensor. If there are any defects as mentioned
below, replace the rear airbag sensor with a new
one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
• Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial
number.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
3.
INSPECT REAR AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG HAS
DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the rear airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
HINT:
The rear airbag sensor on the impacted side should
be replaced after the curtain shield airbag assembly
has deployed.
RS
RS–448
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read "PRECAUTION" thoroughly before
servicing (See page RS-1).
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait for 90 seconds after disconnecting the cable to
prevent the airbag working.
3.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat)
(See page SE-9)
4.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat)
(See page SE-18)
5.
REMOVE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the occupant
classification ECU.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the occupant
classification ECU.
RS
H045341
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
RS–449
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the negative battery (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the negative battery
terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before
starting the operation.
(c) Install the occupant classification ECU.
(d) Connect the 2 connectors to the occupant
classification ECU.
NOTICE:
• If the occupant classification ECU has been
dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or
other defects in the case or connector,
replace it with a new one.
• When installing the occupant classification
ECU, be careful that the SRS wiring does not
interfere with other parts and that it is not
pinched between other parts.
H045341
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat)
(See page SE-13)
3.
INSTALL FRONT RH SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power
Seat) (See page SE-23)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
INSPECT SLIDE ADJUSTER LOCK (for Manual Seat)
6.
INSPECT POWER SEAT OPERATION (for Power
Seat)
7.
INSPECT SEAT HEATER OPERATION (w/ Seat Heater
System)
8.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (See page RS-28).
RS
RS–442
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT TRACK BRACKET
COVER INNER LH
SEAT TRACK BRACKET
COVER INNER FRONT LH
37 (375, 27)
SEAT TRACK
OUTER COVER LH
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
RS
SEAT TRACK BRACKET
COVER OUTER FRONT LH
37 (375, 27)
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C
C131322E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
RS–443
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SEAT POSITION SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
2.
INSPECT SEAT POSITION SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS28).
(b) Even if the airbag was not deployed, check if there
is any damage to the seat position sensor.
If there are any defects as mentioned below, replace
the seat position sensor with a new one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
RS
RS–446
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
RS
C
C131323E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
RS–447
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS297).
2.
INSPECT OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (See page RS297).
(b) Even if the airbag was not deployed, check if there
is any damage to the occupant classification ECU. If
there are any defects as mentioned below, replace
the occupant classification ECU with a new one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the case.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
CAUTION:
Be sure to follow the correct removal and
installation procedures.
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG CUTOFF SWITCH
RS–449
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
CUTOFF SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RSCA OFF INDICATOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the RSCA OFF indicator comes on for
approximately 3 seconds and then goes off.
(c) Check that the RSCA OFF indicator goes off after
pressing the curtain airbag cut off switch for
approximately 2 seconds.
2.
INSPECT CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG CUTOFF
SWITCH
(a) Remove the instrument panel finish panel subassembly lower (See page IP-7).
(b) Remove the curtain airbag cutoff switch from the
instrument panel finish panel sub-assembly lower.
H043802
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
OFF
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SW (3) - E (4)
OFF (Release)
10 kΩ or higher
SW (3) - E (4)
ON (Pushed in)
Below 1 Ω
(d) Inspect the illumination operation.
(1) Connect the battery positive terminal to
terminal ILL+ (2) of the connector, and the
battery negative terminal to terminal ILL- (1),
and check that the indicator comes on.
ON
E
ILL+
RS
SW
ILLH043798E01
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–9
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the inner belt assembly with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER RH
3.
INSTALL SLIDE AND VERTICAL POWER SEAT
SWITCH KNOB (for Power Seat)
4.
INSTALL RECLINING POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB
(for Power Seat)
5.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE HANDLE
RH (for Manual Seat)
6.
INSTALL VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB CAP
(for Manual Seat)
7.
INSPECT VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB RH (for
Manual Seat)
8.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Place the front seat assembly RH in the cabin.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
(b) Connect the connectors under the front seat
assembly RH.
(c) Install the front seat assembly RH with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
SB
SB–12
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to pretensioner
connector.
(a) Inspect the tension reducer operation.
(1) Connect the positive lead from the battery to
terminal 1 of connector A and the negative lead
to terminal 2.
(2) Check that the operating noise that the
magnetized solenoid is attracting the plunger is
heard.
(3) Check that the rewinding volume of the seat
belt increases when the seat belt is pulled out
and the battery negative lead is disconnected.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
outer belt assembly.
Tension Reducer Connector A
Tension Reducer Connector B*
2.
INSPECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to pretensioner
connector.
* Do not apply battery voltage
B064703E01
(a) Inspect the tension reducer operation.
(1) Connect the positive lead from the battery to
terminal 1 of connector A and the negative lead
to terminal 2.
(2) Check that the operating noise that the
magnetized solenoid is attracting the plunger is
heard.
(3) Check that the rewinding volume of the seat
belt increases when the seat belt is pulled out
and the battery negative lead is disconnected.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
outer belt assembly.
Tension Reducer Connector A
SB
Tension Reducer Connector B*
* Do not apply battery voltage
B064703E01
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–13
INSTALLATION
1.
Unlock
Retractor
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(a) Check the degree of tilt when beginning to lock the
ELR.
(1) Check that the belt does not lock within 15° of
tilt in all the direction but the belt locks over 45°
of tilt, when moving the installed retractor
gently.
If operation is not as specified, replace the
outer belt assembly.
(b) Install the retractor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: For upper bolt
8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
For lower bolt
42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the shoulder anchor with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the center pillar garnish upper RH.
(e) Install the center pillar garnish lower RH.
(f) Install the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(g) Install the floor anchor cover.
(h) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) Check that the belt locks when pulling out the
belt quickly with the belt installed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the
outer belt assembly.
45 °
Lock
B065022E01
2.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER RH
3.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
4.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
6.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
SB
SB–14
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
1.
SB
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
(WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• Never dispose of a front seat outer belt assembly
with a pretensioner that has not been deployed.
• The seat belt pretensioner produces an exploding
sound when it deploys, so perform the operation
outdoors where it will not disturb local residents.
• When deploying a front seat outer belt (with a seat
belt pretensioner), perform the operation at least
10 m (33 ft) away from the front seat outer belt.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
front seat belt with a deployed pretensioner.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat outer belt
with a deployed pretensioner.
• When deploying the seat belt pretensioner,
always use the specified SST (SRS airbag
deployment tool). Perform the operation in a place
away from electrical interference.
HINT:
When scrapping vehicles equipped with seat belt
pretensioners or disposing of a front seat outer belt (with
a seat belt pretensioner), always deploy the seat belt
pretensioner first in accordance with the procedures
described below. If any abnormality occurs during
deployment of the seat belt pretensioner, contact the
SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A.,
INC.
(a) Check the function of SST.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
CAUTION:
When deploying the seat belt pretensioner,
always use the specified SST.
SST
B050515E02
Battery
SST
B050511E02
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
HINT:
At this time, do not connect the yellow
connector that will later be connected to the
seat belt pretensioner.
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–15
(2) Press the SST deployment switch, and check
that the LED of the SST deployment switch
lights up.
CAUTION:
If the LED is lit when the deployment switch
is not pressed, the SST may be
malfunctioning. Therefore, do not use the
SST.
SST
B050514E02
SST
(b) Connect SST.
(1) Connect 2 SST, and then connect them to the
front seat outer belt pretensioner.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the pretensioner connector.
SST
B051763E02
10 m (33 ft) or more
B050513E02
B060422
(2) Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from
the front of the vehicle.
(3) Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the SST wire harness.
(c) Deploy the front seat outer belt pretensioner.
(1) Confirm that no one is inside the vehicle or
within a 10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) terminal.
(3) Press the SST deployment switch and deploy
the front seat outer belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner will deploy at the
same time as the LED of the SST illuminates.
(d) Dispose of the front seat outer belt assembly.
(1) Remove the SST.
(2) Place the outer belt in a plastic bag, tie the end
tightly and dispose of it in the same way as
other general parts.
CAUTION:
• The outer belt becomes very hot when
the front seat outer belt pretensioner is
deployed, so leave it untouched for at
least 30 minutes after it has been
deployed.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling an outer belt with a
pretensioner that has been deployed.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
SB
SB–16
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat
outer belt assembly with a pretensioner
that has been deployed.
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the front seat
outer belt pretensioners, and then scrap the
vehicle with the deployed outer belt installed.
2.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• When disposing of a pretensioner equipped front
seat outer belt, never deploy the belt in the
customer's vehicle.
• Be sure to follow the procedures listed below
when deploying the seat belt pretensioner.
(a) Check the function of SST.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
CAUTION:
When deploying the seat belt pretensioner,
always use the specified SST.
SST
B050515E02
Battery
SST
SB
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
HINT:
At this time, do not connect the yellow
connector that will later be connected to the
seat belt pretensioner.
B050511E02
(2) Press the SST deployment switch, and check
that the LED of the SST deployment switch
lights up.
CAUTION:
If the LED is lit when the deployment switch
is not pressed, the SST may be
malfunctioning. Therefore, do not use the
SST.
SST
B050514E02
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SST
SB–17
(b) Connect SST.
(1) Connect 2 SST, and then connect them to the
front seat outer belt pretensioner.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the pretensioner connector.
SST
B051763E02
SST
(2) Place the outer belt on the ground and cover it
with a tire and wheel assembly.
NOTICE:
Position the front seat outer belt assembly
as shown in the illustration.
(3) Position and hold the SST at least 10 m (33 ft)
away from the wheel.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the SST wire harness.
SST
B069491E02
10 m (33 ft) or more
B050541E03
B060422
(c) Deploy the front seat outer belt pretensioner.
(1) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius
of the wheel.
(2) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(3) Press the SST deployment switch and deploy
the front seat outer belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner will deploy at the
same time as the LED of the SST illuminates.
(d) Dispose of the front seat outer belt assembly.
(1) Remove the wheel and SST.
(2) Place the outer belt in a plastic bag, tie the end
tightly and dispose of it in the same way as
other general parts.
CAUTION:
• The outer belt becomes very hot when
the front seat outer belt pretensioner is
deployed, so leave it untouched for at
least 30 minutes after it has been
deployed.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling an outer belt with a
pretensioner that has been deployed.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
• Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat
outer belt assembly with a pretensioner
that has been deployed.
SB
SB–18
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the front seat
outer belt pretensioners, and then scrap the
vehicle with the deployed outer belt installed.
SB
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT TENSION REDUCER
SB–1
SEAT BELT TENSION REDUCER
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
SB
SOLENOID
C131305E02
SB–2
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT TENSION REDUCER
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
SEAT BELT TENSION REDUCER SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. GAUGE fuse
Tension reducer for driver side seat belt does not
operate
Tension reducer for passenger side seat belt does not
operate
-
2. Front seat inner belt assembly LH
SB-6
3. Front seat outer belt assembly LH
SB-11
4. Wire harness
-
1. GAUGE fuse
-
2. Front seat inner belt assembly RH
SB-7
3. Front seat outer belt assembly RH
SB-11
4. Wire harness
SB
See page
-
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–19
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
INSTALL REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for
Rear No. 1 Seat)
2.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
LH
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
SB
SB–3
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER (DRIVE SIDE SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT)
PASSENGER SIDE SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT WARNING SENSOR
(BUILT IN PASSENGER SIDE SEAT)
SB
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
C131306E02
SB–4
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Fuse
2. Combination meter assembly
Driver side seat belt warning light does not operate
3. Center airbag sensor assembly
4. Front seat inner belt assembly LH
5. Wire harness
Passenger side seat belt warning light does not
operate
RS-23
SB-6
-
1. Fuse
-
2. Passenger side seat belt warning light assembly
-
3. Front seat inner belt assembly RH
4. Wire harness
SB
See page
SB-7
-
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SB–21
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
Claw
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT RH
(a) Disengage the claws and remove the seat leg cover.
B064892E02
(b) Release the rear seat lock and remove the seat.
(c) Remove the headrests.
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
LH
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the nut and seat beat inner.
B064896E01
SB
SB–22
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
SB
1.
INSTALL REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
LH
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT RH (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Install the belt with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
SB–5
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER RH
FRONT SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR
ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
REAR DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP RH
FRONT DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP RH
42 (430, 31)
REAR DOOR
SCUFF PLATE RH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
SB
42 (430, 31)
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131307E04
SB–6
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for LH and RH.
1.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
2.
REMOVE VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB RH (for
Manual Seat)
3.
REMOVE VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB CAP
(for Manual Seat) (See page SE-10)
4.
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTING HANDLE NO. 2 (for
Manual Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 screws and vertical adjusting handle
No. 2.
5.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE
HANDLE RH (for Manual Seat)
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the reclining adjuster
release handle LH.
6.
REMOVE RECLINING POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB
(for Power Seat)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the reclining power
seat switch knob.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE SLIDE AND VERTICAL POWER SEAT
SWITCH KNOB (for Power Seat)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the slide & vertical
power seat switch knob.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER RH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and clip,
and remove the front seat cushion shield inner RH
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
9.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB
INSPECTION
Buckle Switch ON
1.
A
A
3 21
6 54
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Inspect the buckle switch.
(1) Fasten the seat belt (Buckle switch is ON).
(2) Inspect the continuity and resistance between
the terminals.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
B060004E01
Specified Condition
A-6 - A-3
1,330 Ω
A-4 - A-3
Continuity
A-5 - A-3
* Continuity
SB–7
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
* When the positive and negative poles
between terminals are exchanged, there is
continuity in one way but no continuity in
the other way.
(3) Release the seat belt (Buckle switch is OFF).
(4) Inspect the continuity and resistance between
the terminals.
Standard resistance
Buckle Switch OFF
A
A
3 21
6 54
330 Ω
A-4 - A-3
No Continuity
A-5 - A-3
* No Continuity
(b) Inspect the circuit for the airbag seat position
sensor.
(1) Inspect the continuity between connector A and
the connector for the airbag seat position
sensor.
Standard resistance
A
Connector for Airbag
Seat Position Sensor
3 2 1
Specified Condition
A-6 - A-3
NOTICE:
* When the positive and negative poles
between terminals are exchanged, there is
no continuity in either way.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
inner belt assembly.
B060004E02
A
Terminal No.
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
A-2 - 1
(Connector for airbag seat position sensor)
A-1 - 2
(Connector for airbag seat position sensor)
12
6 5 4
Continuity
If the result is not as specified, replace the
inner belt assembly.
SB
B065625E01
2.
Buckle Switch ON
A
A
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Inspect the buckle switch.
(1) Fasten the seat belt (Buckle switch is ON).
(2) Inspect the continuity and resistance between
the terminals.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
B059310E01
Specified Condition
A-2 - A-4
1,330 Ω
A-1 - A-3
Continuity
SB–8
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(3) Release the seat belt (Buckle switch is OFF).
(4) Inspect the continuity and resistance between
the terminals.
Standard resistance
Buckle Switch OFF
A
A
Terminal No.
B059310E03
SB
Specified Condition
A-1 - A-3
330 Ω
A-2 - A-4
No Continuity
If the result is not as specified, replace the
inner belt assembly.
SB–26
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
4.
REMOVE NO.2 SEAT LEG COVER (with Rear No. 2
Seat)
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(with Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seat lock.
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
7.
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (without
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the deck board subassembly.
8.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (without Rear
No. 2 Seat)
HINT:
See page IR-7
9.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR
HINT:
See page IR-7
10. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX RH
(a) Remove the bolt, deck floor box and luggage hold
belt striker.
SB
11. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the trim cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
12. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
(a) Remove the screw and side board.
13. REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the screw and side trim box.
14. REMOVE QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
15. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
16. REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
17. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
18. REMOVE REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–27
19. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the floor anchor cover.
(b) Remove the bolt and seat belt assembly outer on
the floor anchor side.
(c) Remove the side panel assembly .
20. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(with Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the floor anchor cover.
(b) Remove the bolt and No. 2 seat belt outer RH on
the floor anchor side.
(c) Remove the side panel.
21. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
22. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (with Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 2 seat belt outer RH on
the shoulder anchor side.
(b) Remove the side garnish.
23. REMOVE 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY RH (for
Rear No. 1 Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts on the retractor side, and
thoroughly remove the seat belt.
SB
SB–9
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER RH
FRONT SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR
ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
REAR DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP RH
FRONT DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP RH
42 (430, 31)
REAR DOOR
SCUFF PLATE RH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
SB
42 (430, 31)
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131307E05
SB–10
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
Claw A
A
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
6.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 6 claws labeled
A and 2 claws labeled B. Remove the 2 clips and
pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER RH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the front seat outer
belt (floor anchor side).
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 6 claws and clip,
and remove the pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
NOTICE:
• Removal operation concerning the seat belt with
the pretensioner must be started in 90 seconds or
more after the ignition switch is turned OFF and
the battery negative terminal is disconnected.
• Carefully read the notices for the "pretensioner"
in the SRS airbag system and the outer belt
assembly.
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the front seat outer
belt on the shoulder anchor side.
B
A
Clip
1.
Claw B
A
B064143E01
Clip
Claw
B063595E01
SB
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–11
(b) Disconnect the pretensioner connector as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and the outer belt assembly.
B065506E01
SB
SB–28
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
Unlock
45 q
Lock
SB
B065024E01
INSTALL 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(b) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
(1) When the inclination of the retractor is 15°or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from the
retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is
over 45°, check that the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(c) Install the rear seat belt inner with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the seat shoulder belt cover.
(e) Install the seatback board RH.
(f) Install the belt on the retractor side with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(g) Install the belt LH on the floor anchor side with the
bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(h) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) With the belt installed, check that the belt locks
when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(i) Check the fastening function of the child restraint
system.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) When the belt is pulled out fully, the belt should
automatically try to retract.
(2) After the belt has fully retracted, the belt should
be able to be pulled out and retract again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
2.
Unlock
45 °
Lock
B065025E01
SB–29
REMOVE 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(without Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(b) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
(1) When the inclination of the retractor is 15° or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from the
retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is
over 45°, check that the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(c) Install the rear seat 3 point type belt inner with the
bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the belt assembly on the retractor side with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: for upper bolt
8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 ft.*lbf)
for lower bolt
42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(e) 3rd seat type:
Install the No. 2 seat belt outer RH on the shoulder
anchor side with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the roof side garnish inner RH.
(g) Install the deck trim side panel RH.
(h) Install the belt outer on the floor anchor side with the
bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(i) 3rd seat type:
Install the No. 2 seat belt outer RH on the floor
anchor side with the bolt.
(j) Install the floor anchor cover.
(k) 3rd seat type:
Install the floor anchor cover.
(l) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) With the belt installed, check that the belt locks
when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(m) Check fastening function of the child restraint
system.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) When the belt is pulled out fully, the belt should
automatically try to retract.
SB
SB–30
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
(2) After the belt has fully retracted, the belt should
be able to be pulled out and retract again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
3.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (with Rear No. 2 Seat)
4.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH INNER RH
5.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(with Rear No. 2 Seat)
6.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
7.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
8.
INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
9.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
10. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
11. INSTALL QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
12. INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
13. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
14. INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
15. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX RH
16. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
17. INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (without Rear
No. 2 Seat)
18. INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (without
Rear No. 2 Seat)
19. INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
SB
20. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(with Rear No. 2 Seat)
21. INSTALL NO. 2 SEAT LEG COVER (with Rear No. 2
Seat)
22. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
23. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
24. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–17
REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
REAR FLOOR SEAT LOCK COVER
SEAT ANCHOR
RAIL NO. 4
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
REAR FLOOR
CARPET ASSEMBLY
ROPE HOOK
SB
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT 3 POINT
TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER LH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131311E05
SB–18
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
SB
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
LH
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for
Rear No. 1 Seat)
(a) Remove the bolt and belt.
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SB–33
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
4.
REMOVE NO.2 SEAT LEG COVER
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seat lock.
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
7.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR
8.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seat lock.
9.
REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the trim cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
10. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
(a) Remove the screw and side board.
11. REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the screw and side trim box.
12. REMOVE QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH
13. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
14. REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
15. REMOVE REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
16. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the floor anchor cover.
(b) Remove the bolt and seat belt outer on the floor
anchor side.
(c) Remove the shoulder anchor cover.
(d) Remove the bolt and seat belt outer on the shoulder
anchor side.
(e) Remove the trim side panel.
17. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
18. REMOVE 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY RH (for
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts on the retractor side, and
thoroughly remove the seat belt.
SB
SB–34
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
SB
INSTALL 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY RH (for
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(b) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
(1) When the inclination of the retractor is 15° or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from the
retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is
over 45°, check that the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(c) Install the rear No. 2 seat belt inner with the bolt and
nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the belt on the retractor side with the 2 bolts.
Torque: for upper bolt
8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 ft.*lbf)
for lower bolt
42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the roof side garnish inner RH.
(f) Install the belt outer on the shoulder anchor side
with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(g) Install the deck trim side panel RH.
(h) Install the belt outer on the floor anchor side with the
bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(i) Install the floor anchor cover.
(j) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) With the belt installed, check that the belt locks
when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(k) Check the fastening function of the child restraint
system.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt installed.
(1) When the belt is pulled out fully, the belt should
automatically try to retract.
(2) After the belt has fully retracted, the belt should
be able to be pulled out and retract again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SB–35
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
4.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
6.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
7.
INSTALL QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH
8.
INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
9.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
10. INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
11. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX RH
12. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
13. INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
14. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY
15. INSTALL NO.2 SEAT LEG COVER
16. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
17. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
18. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
SB
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SB–19
REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
LEG COVER
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
DECK TRIM SIDE
PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
COVER
REAR DOOR
SUCFF PLATE RH
QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INSIDE RH
42 (430, 31)
SB
NO. 2 SEAT BELT
ASSEMBLY OUTER RH
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131312E03
SB–20
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
FLOOR SEAT LOCK COVER
REAR FLOOR MAT
SUPPORT PLATE REAR
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
REAR FLOOR
CARPET ASSEMBLY
ROPE HOOK
SB
REAR NO. 2 SEAT BELT SUB-ASSEMBLY INNER (RH)
REAR NO. 2 SEAT BELT SUB-ASSEMBLY INNER (LH)
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131313E03
SB–38
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
SB
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
RH
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER
CENTER (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
(a) Remove the bolt and belt.
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–39
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER
CENTER (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
2.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
RH
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
SB
SB–22
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
without REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR DOOR
SCUFF
PLATE RH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL
ASSEMBLY RH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
SB
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT 3
POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY INNER
3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER CENTER
REAR SEAT INNER WITH CENTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131308E04
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
without REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
SB–23
BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
SB
REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY
C131309E03
SB–24
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
LEG COVER
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
ASSEMBLY RH
COVER
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH
REAR OUTER
ANCHOR PLATE RH
42 (430, 31)
3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT SHOULDER
BELT COVER
SB
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
FLOOR ANCHOR
COVER
42 (430, 31)
3 POINT TYPE SEAT
BELT ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131310E03
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
SB–25
BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
REAR FLOOR SEAT LOCK COVER
SEAT ANCHOR
RAIL NO. 4
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
REAR FLOOR
CARPET ASSEMBLY
ROPE HOOK
REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT 3 POINT
TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY
SB
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER LH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131311E06
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SB–31
REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
LEG COVER
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
DECK TRIM SIDE
PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
COVER
REAR DOOR
SUCFF PLATE RH
QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INSIDE RH
42 (430, 31)
SB
3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131312E04
SB–32
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 2 Seat)
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
FLOOR SEAT LOCK COVER
REAR FLOOR MAT
SUPPORT PLATE REAR
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
REAR FLOOR
CARPET ASSEMBLY
ROPE HOOK
SB
REAR NO. 2 SEAT BELT SUB-ASSEMBLY INNER (RH)
REAR NO. 2 SEAT BELT SUB-ASSEMBLY INNER (LH)
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131313E03
SB–36
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
REAR CENTER SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No.
1 Seat)
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
without REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR DOOR
SCUFF
PLATE RH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL
ASSEMBLY RH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
SB
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT 3
POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY INNER
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE
BELT ASSEMBLY
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER CENTER
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER CENTER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131308E05
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
SB–37
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
REAR FLOOR SEAT LOCK COVER
SEAT ANCHOR
RAIL NO. 4
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
REAR FLOOR
CARPET ASSEMBLY
ROPE HOOK
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT 3 POINT
TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY
SB
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER LH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131311E05
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–43
REMOVAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY (with Rear No. 2 Seat)
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
4.
REMOVE NO.2 SEAT LEG COVER (with Rear No. 2
Seat)
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(with Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seat lock.
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
7.
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (without
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the deck board subassembly.
8.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (without Rear
No. 2 Seat) (See page IR-7)
9.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR
HINT:
See page IR-7
10. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX RH
(a) Remove the bolt, deck floor box and luggage hold
belt striker.
11. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the trim cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
12. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
(a) Remove the screw and side board.
13. REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the screw and side trim box.
14. REMOVE QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
15. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
16. REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
17. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
18. REMOVE REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
19. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the floor anchor cover.
SB
SB–44
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
(b) Remove the bolt and seat belt assembly outer on
the floor anchor side.
(c) Remove the side panel assembly.
20. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY (with
Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the floor anchor cover.
(b) Remove the bolt and No. 2 seat belt outer RH on
the floor anchor side.
(c) Remove the side panel.
21. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
22. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (with Rear No. 2 Seat)
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 2 seat belt outer RH on
the shoulder anchor side.
(b) Remove the side garnish.
23. REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER
CENTER
(a) Remove the rear seatback board RH.
(b) Remove the rear seat shoulder belt cover.
(c) Remove the nut and rear seat belt.
SB
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–45
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH and RH.
1.
Unlock
45 q
Lock
B065024E01
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER
CENTER (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
(a) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(b) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
(1) When the inclination of the retractor is 15° or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from the
retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is
over 45°, check that the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
(c) Install the belt with the bolt as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not make the anchor part run onto the
protrusion part of the floor panel.
(d) Install the belt on the retractor side with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the seat shoulder belt cover.
(f) Install the seatback board RH.
(g) Install the belt outer on the floor anchor side with the
bolt.
(h) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) With the belt installed, check that the belt locks
when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assy.
(i) Check the fastening function of the child restraint
system.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) When the belt is pulled out fully, the belt should
automatically try to retract.
(2) After the belt has fully retracted, the belt should
be able to be pulled out and retract again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
Protrusion
Front
B063904E01
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (w/ Rear No. 2 Seat)
3.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
SB
SB–46
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
4.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY (w/
Rear No. 2 Seat)
5.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
7.
INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
8.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
9.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
10. INSTALL QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH (w/
Rear No. 2 Seat)
11. INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
12. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
13. INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
14. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX RH
15. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
16. INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (w/o Rear No. 2
Seat)
17. INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/o Rear
No. 2 Seat)
18. INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
19. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
20. INSTALL NO.2 SEAT LEG COVER (w/ Rear No. 2
Seat)
21. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (w/ Rear
No. 2 Seat)
22. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (w/ Rear
No. 2 Seat)
SB
23. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY (w/ Rear No. 2 Seat)
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–39
REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear
No. 1 Seat)
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
without REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR DOOR
SCUFF
PLATE RH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL
ASSEMBLY RH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
SB
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT 3
POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY INNER
3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
FLOOR ANCHOR COVER
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER CENTER
REAR SEAT INNER WITH CENTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131308E04
SB–40
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
without REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
SB
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
AND REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
C131309E04
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
SB–41
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER RH
REAR DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP RH
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
LEG COVER
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
ASSEMBLY RH
COVER
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INNER RH
REAR OUTER
ANCHOR PLATE RH
42 (430, 31)
3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT SHOULDER
BELT COVER
SB
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
FLOOR ANCHOR
COVER
42 (430, 31)
3 POINT TYPE SEAT
BELT ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131310E03
SB–42
SEAT BELT – REAR CENTER SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY (for Rear No. 1 Seat)
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
REAR FLOOR SEAT LOCK COVER
SEAT ANCHOR
RAIL NO. 4
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
REAR FLOOR
CARPET ASSEMBLY
SB
ROPE HOOK
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT 3 POINT
TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY INNER LH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C131311E05
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–3
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
OUTLINE OF THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
• The theft deterrent system will operate when
someone attempts to forcibly enter the vehicle, unlock
any door or open the engine hood without using the
key.
This system causes the lights to light up or blink and
the horns to sound in order to deter break-in and theft.
• The theft deterrent system has 2 modes; one is the
active arming mode (see ACTIVE ARMING MODE)
and the other is passive arming mode (see PASSIVE
ARMING MODE). The passive arming mode can be
switched ON/OFF using the specified method.
• Each mode has 4 states; a disarmed state, an arming
preparation state, an armed state and an alarm
sounding state.
(a) Disarmed state:
• The alarm function is not operating.
• The theft deterrent system is not operating.
(b) Arming preparation state:
• The time until the system goes into the armed
state.
• The theft deterrent system is not operating.
(c) Armed state:
• The theft deterrent system is operating.
(d) Alarm sounding state:
• Alarm function is operating.
Alarm time:
(60 +- 5 sec.) x 10
HINT:
If the vehicle remains in a condition that sets off the
alarm (any door remains open, engine hood
remains open, ignition switch remains directly
connected) after the alarm ends, the alarm will be
set off repeatedly a maximum of 10 times for every
one of the above specified conditions.
Refer to table below for alarm method and time:
Alarm Method
Alarm Time
Headlight
Blinking (cycle of 0.4 sec.)
Taillight
Blinking (cycle of 0.4 sec.)
Hazard Warning Light
Blinking (cycle of flasher relay)
Interior Light
Illuminating
Vehicle Horn
Sounding
(approx. 0.4 second cycles)
Security Horn
Sounding
(approx. 0.4 second cycles)
Approx. 60 sec. (maximum 10 times)
HINT:
If any of the doors are unlocked when the key is not
in the key cylinder during the armed state, a forced
door lock signal will be output (see FORCED DOOR
LOCK CONTROL).
TD
TD–4
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2.
ACTIVE ARMING MODE
HINT:
Active arming mode starts the alarm control immediately
after the doors are locked.
(a) Active arming mode:
This system activates as described in the diagram
below when one of items for each condition is met.
Disarmed State
Condition (3)
Condition (1)
Arming Preparation State
Condition (2)
Condition (5)
Armed State
Condition (6)
Condition (5)
Condition (4)
Alarm Sounding State
TD
B112141E01
Condition
Item
Condition (1)
In the disarmed state, when the key is not in the key cylinder, the system state is switched if one of
the following conditions is met.
1. With all doors, engine hood closed, lock all doors by key operation.
2. With all doors, engine hood closed, lock all doors by wireless operation.
3. Lock all doors without using key and perform either of the following.
– Open any door or the engine hood and then close them all and lock all doors.
– Leave all doors locked and engine hood closed.
Condition (2)
1.
After condition (1) is met, allow approx. 30 seconds to elapse.
Condition (3)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Unlock all doors by wireless operation.
Unlock all doors by key operation.
Unlock any door.
Open any door.
Open engine hood.
Insert key into ignition key cylinder.
Turn the ignition switch OFF to ON.
Reconnect battery.
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Condition
TD–5
Item
Condition (4)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Open engine hood.
Reconnect battery.
Open any door.
Open any door without key and wireless operation.
Directly connect ignition switch without key (or turn ignition switch ON without key).
Condition (5)
1. Insert key into ignition key cylinder, turn ignition switch ON and run engine over 550 rpm for 10
to 12 sec.
2. Unlock all doors by wireless operation.
3. Unlock all doors by key operation.
4. Insert key into ignition key cylinder and turn ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Condition (6)
1. After approx. 60 seconds, alarm stops and system returns to armed state.
3.
PASSIVE ARMING MODE
HINT:
• Passive arming mode starts the alarm control when
the key is not in key cylinder and doors are closed.
• Passive arming mode can be switched ON/OFF by
the specified method.
• The alarm is initially set (when shipped from factory)
to active arming mode (not passive arming mode).
• During passive arming mode, the theft deterrent
system goes into the armed state even if the doors
are not locked.
• Detecting that the doors are unlocked does not set off
the alarm during passive arming mode.
• A forced door lock signal is not output during passive
arming mode (see FORCED DOOR LOCK
CONTROL).
• Although the theft deterrent system detects that the
doors are opened during passive arming mode, the
alarm will not go off immediately because an entry
delay time is set.
• If any of the following conditions is met during passive
arming mode, the theft deterrent system will switch to
active arming mode.
– With all doors and engine hood closed, lock all
doors by key operation.
– With all doors and engine hood closed, lock all
doors by wireless operation.
– Lock all doors without using key and perform either
of the following.
Open any door or the engine hood and then close
them all and lock all doors. / Leave all doors locked
and engine hood closed.
TD
TD–6
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
(a) Passive arming mode:
This system activates as described in the diagram
below when one of items for each condition is met.
Disarmed State
Condition (1)
Disarmed State (1) *1
Disarmed State (2) *2
Condition (3)
Condition (3)
Condition (2)
Arming Preparation State
Condition (5)
Condition (4)
Condition (7)
Armed State
Condition (8)
Condition (6)
Condition (7)
Alarm Sounding State
TD
B125108E01
HINT:
• *1: Disarmed state 1 is the normal disarmed
state.
• *2: Disarmed state 2 is set from either the
disarmed state 1 or the arming preparation state.
Condition
Item
Condition (1)
1. With ignition switch OFF, open any door and pull the key out of the ignition key cylinder.
2. With ignition switch OFF, pull the key out of the ignition key cylinder and open any door.
Condition (2)
1. With engine hood closed, close all doors..
2. With engine hood and all doors closed, close back door.
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Condition
TD–7
Item
Condition (3)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Unlock all doors by wireless operation.
Unlock all doors by key operation.
Reconnect battery.
Insert key into ignition key cylinder.
Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Condition (4)
1. After condition (1) is met, allow approx. 30 seconds to elapse.
Condition (5)
1. Open any door.
2. Open engine hood.
3. Open back door.
Condition (6)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Condition (7)
1. Unlock all doors by wireless operation.
2. Unlock all doors by key operation.
3. Insert key into ignition key cylinder and turn ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Condition (8)
1. After approx. 60 sec., alarm stops and system returns to armed state.
Open any door and allow entry delay time*1 to elapse.
Open engine hood.
Reconnect battery.
Turn the ignition switch ON without using key.
HINT:
*1: When any door is opened while all the doors are
closed during passive arming mode, the entry delay
time starts. If the switch condition (armed state →
disarmed state 1 or 2) is met during the entry delay
time, the theft deterrent system will return to
disarmed state 1 or 2. However, if the switch
condition for disarmed state 1 or 2 is not met, the
theft deterrent system will recognize it as a theft and
set off the alarm. Entry delay time of 0, 14 or 30 sec.
can be selected by the customizing function.
TD
TD–8
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
4.
PROCEDURE FOR CHANGING OF PASSIVE MODE
(ON OR OFF)
Vehicle initial condition
- No key in the ignition key cylinder
- Only the driver side door opened
- All the doors unlocked
Within 5
seconds
Insert and remove the key from the ignition
key cylinder 3 times.
: Input to the vehicle
: Output from the vechicle
Close the driver side door.
: CORRECT
Lock and unlock all the doors 3 times by
key or wireless transmitter.
*1
: INCORRECT
*2
Within 40
secounds
Open and close the driver side door
*1
Lock and unlock the driver side door lock
knob 3 times.
TD
*1
*2
Open the driver side door.
2 seconds
The system performs forced door lock once
(answer-back)
*1: Any door courtesy OFF to ON
*2: Any door lock UNLOCK to LOCK
E112668E04
TD–9
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
*2: Any door lock UNLOCK to LOCK
*3: Driver side door OPEN to CLOSE
*4: “Driver side door OPEN to CLOSE” is
performed once in the previous step.
The system performs forced door lock once
(answer-back)
*2
*3
*3, 4
Unlock the driver side door lock knob.
To active mode
To passive mode
Within 20
seconds Close and open the driver side door twice.
*2
Close and open 6 times or more
the driver side
door 3 to 5 times.
3 times
Lock and unlock the driver side door lock
knob.
*3, 4
5 times
Lock and unlock the driver side
door lock knob.
* 0 sec.
2 seconds
4 times
* 14 sec.
* 30 sec.
The system performs forced door lock once
(answer-back)
The system performs forced door
lock once (answer-back)
ACTIVE MODE ON (PASSIVE MODE OFF)
PASSIVE MODE ON
TD
E112669E01
HINT:
• Initial mode is PASSIVE MODE OFF.
• If the ignition switch is turned ON, change will be
cancelled.
• * Entry delay time.
TD–10
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
5.
6.
TD
7.
FORCED DOOR LOCK CONTROL
(a) The forced door lock control prevents the vehicle
from being tampered with. Immediately after a door
is unlocked (alarm starts), the door is forced to lock
by a forced door lock signal.
(1) Conditions that force the doors to lock:
When the key is not in the key cylinder and 0.4
seconds have elapsed after the previous output
of a forced door lock signal, the doors will be
forced to lock if any of the following conditions is
met:
• The theft deterrent system is in the alarm
sounding state of active arming mode.
• Any door is unlocked.
ALARM MEMORY FUNCTION
(a) If the alarm is set off (tampering is detected) while
the theft deterrent system is armed, it will be
recorded by the alarm memory function. Whenever
the theft deterrent system is cancelled, the alarm
memory function causes the taillights to light up for
2 seconds in order to inform you that the alarm has
been set off.
(1) Conditions of the alarm memory function that
cause the taillights to light up:
When the theft deterrent system has entered
into the alarm sounding state (tampering has
been detected) even once, the taillights will light
up for 2 seconds if any of the following
conditions is met.
• Switched to the disarmed state from the
armed state during active arming mode.
• Switched to the disarmed state 1 from the
armed state during passive arming mode.
• Switched to the disarmed state (2) from the
armed state during passive mode.
HINT:
Active arming mode: See ACTIVE ARMING
MODE.
Passive arming mode: See PASSIVE ARMING
MODE.
PANIC ALARM CONTROL
(a) The panic alarm control makes it possible to
voluntarily set off the panic alarm by pressing the
PANIC (LOCK) switch on the wireless transmitter.
(1) Conditions that cause the panic alarm control to
set off the panic alarm:
The panic alarm control sets off the panic alarm
by pressing the PANIC (LOCK) switch on the
wireless transmitter over 2.4 seconds under the
following conditions:
• The ignition switch is OFF.
TD–11
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
8.
• The theft deterrent system is not in the alarm
sounding state. (This condition is common
both to active arming mode and to passive
arming mode.)
(2) Conditions that cause the panic alarm control to
shut off the alarm:
The panic alarm control shuts off the panic alarm
when any of the following conditions is met
during panic alarm operation:
• The ignition switch is ON.
• Either of the switches on the wireless
transmitter (LOCK/UNLOCK) is pressed.
• The panic alarm ends (approx. 60 sec. have
passed).
• The theft deterrent system switches to the
alarm sounding state. Under this condition,
the theft deterrent system is controlling the
alarm rather than the panic alarm control. In
order to cancel this alarm, refer to the theft
deterrent system alarm sounding state
cancellation procedure. (This condition is
common both to active arming mode to
passive arming mode.)
HINT:
Active arming mode: See ACTIVE ARMING
MODE.
Passive arming mode: See PASSIVE ARMING
MODE.
SECURITY INDICATOR OUTPUT
(a) The theft warning ECU outputs a signal to light up
the security indicator, according to the state of the
theft deterrent system. However, some of the actual
lighting conditions of the security indicator are
different from the output signals of the theft warning
ECU.
Output:
State of Theft Deterrent System*
Disarmed state 1, 2
Security Indicator
Output Signals from Theft warning ECU
Actual Lighting Condition
OFF
OFF (Immobiliser system unset)
BLINKING (Immobiliser system set)
Arming preparation state
ON
ON
Armed state
OFF
BLINKING
Alarm sounding state
ON
ON
Blinking cycle:
Time
Security Indicator
0.2 sec.
ON
1.8 sec.
OFF
HINT:
• *: The above condition is common both to active
arming mode and to passive arming mode.
TD
TD–12
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
• When the immobiliser system is set, the security
indicator blinks during both the disarmed state
and the armed state, due to the output signals
from the immobiliser system.
TD
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–13
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the theft deterrent
system.
• The intelligent tester should be used in step 3.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Interview the customer to confirm the trouble (See page
IN-30).
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check for normal function of
the multiplex communication system.
(1) (ECU unconnected, communication line
malfunctioning) If no code is output, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU unconnected, communication line
malfunctioning) If any code is output, proceed to B.
B
Go To MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SECTION
A
4
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
TD
NEXT
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) If the fault is not listed in the problem symptoms table,
proceed to A.
(b) If the fault is listed in the problem symptoms table,
proceed to B.
B
A
Go to step 7
TD–14
6
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING ACCORDING TO MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
(a) Terminals of ECU (See page TD-14)
7
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
TD
CONFIRMATION TEST
TD–15
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Proceed to the reference page shown in the table below for
each malfunction symptom and troubleshoot each circuit.
HINT:
Troubleshooting of the theft deterrent system is based on the
premise that the door lock control system and the wireless
door lock control system are operating normally. Accordingly,
before troubleshooting the theft deterrent system, first make
certain that the door lock control system and the wireless
door lock control system are operating normally.
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Symptom
Theft deterrent system cannot be set.
Suspected area
See page
1. Security indicator light circuit
TD-24
2. ECU power source circuit
TD-26
3. Un-lock warning switch circuit
DL-66
4. Door key lock and unlock switch
DL-77
5. Back door key lock and unlock switch
DL-80
6. Door courtesy switch circuit
TD-14
7. Back door courtesy switch circuit
TD-14
8. Engine hood courtesy switch circuit
TD-18
Security indicator light does not blink when theft
deterrent system is set.
Security indicator light circuit
TD-24
Alarm sounding state is not canceled when ignition
switch is turned ON-OFF 10 times within 15 seconds.
1. Ignition switch circuit
TD-22
2. Un-lock warning switch circuit
DL-66
Theft deterrent system can be set even when any door
is open.
Door courtesy switch circuit
TD-14
Horn does not sound while theft deterrent system is in
warning operation.
Security horn circuit
TD-20
Headlights do not flash while theft deterrent system is
in warning operation.
Headlight circuit
LI-20
Taillights do not flash while theft deterrent system is in
warning operation.
Taillights circuit
LI-31
Hazard warning lights do not flash while theft deterrent
system is in warning operation.
Hazard warning switch
LI-70
Interior light does not flash while theft deterrent system
is in warning operation.
Interior light circuit
LI-25
Horn sounds even when theft deterrent system is not
set.
Security horn circuit
TD-20
Headlights flash even when theft deterrent system is
not set.
Headlight circuit
LI-20
Taillights flash even when theft deterrent system is not
set.
Taillights circuit
LI-31
Hazard warning lights flash even when theft deterrent
system is not set.
Hazard warning switch circuit
LI-70
Interior light flashes even when theft deterrent system
is not set.
Interior light circuit
LI-25
TD
TD–16
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY (THEFT
DETERRENT ECU)
T5
B050657E07
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector, and check the
voltage or continuity between each terminal of the
wire harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
E (T5-29) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
+B2 (T5-3) - E (T5-29)
W-L - W-B
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (T5-10) - E (T5-29)
B-R - W-B
Ignition switch OFF to ON
+B1 (T5-2) - E (T5-29)
W-R - W-B
Always
Specified Condition
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the T5 ECU connector, and check the
voltage between each terminal of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
IND (T5-25) - E (T5-29)
GR-G - W-B
Security indicator light lights up.
(It lights up only for 30 sec. in alarming sounding state.
It flashes when immobiliser system is operating)
3 to 6 V
SH- (T5-1) - E (T5-29)
BR-B - W-B
Security horn is sounding.
(Theft deterrent system is in alarming sounding state)
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may
malfunction.
TD
TD–17
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2.
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (BODY ECU)
B6
1F
1A
1E
1K
B5
1C
1D
1H
B4
1B
1J
1L
1G
Connector 1F
Connector 1C
Connector B6
Connector 1K
Body ECU
Connector 1H
Connector 1D
Connector 1J
Connector 1E
Connector B5
Connector 1L
Connector 1A
TD
Connector B4
Connector 1B
Connector 1G
B065529E01
TD–18
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
(a) Disconnect the J/B connector, and check the
voltage or continuity between each terminal of the
wire harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
BDR1 (1E-9) - Body
ground
Condition
Specified Condition
G-W - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
GND1 (1H-2) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 (1H-2) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
KSW (B6-14) - Body
ground
G-Y - Body ground
No key in ignition key cylinder → Key inserted
10 kΩ or higher → Below
1Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the J/B connector, and check the voltage
between each terminal of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
DCTY (B5-23) - Body
ground
Condition
R-B - Body ground
Driver side door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
PCTY (B5-24) - Body
ground
R-Y - Body ground
Passenger side door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
RLCY (B5-11) - Body
ground
P-B - Body ground
Rear door LH CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
RRCY (B5-12) - Body
ground
P-L - Body ground
Rear door RH CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
ACT+ (1L-9) - Body
ground
L-R - Body ground
Master switch and driver side door key cylinder OFF →
LOCK
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
ACT- (1L-18) - Body
ground
L-B - Body ground
Master switch and driver side door key cylinder OFF →
UNLOCK
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
3.
Specified Condition
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may
malfunction.
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
(BACK DOOR ECU)
B9
B8
TD
B062706E03
(a) Disconnect the B8 ECU connector, and check the
voltage of each terminal of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
BDR (B8-4) - Body ground
L - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
BECU (B8-5) - Body
ground
L-R - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (B8-3) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
TD–19
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the B8 ECU connector, and check the
voltage of each terminal of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
ACT+ (B9-15) - Body
ground
L-B - Body ground
Back door OPEN → NOT COMPLETELY CLOSED →
Monitor in normal rotation (Right turn) → Motor in
reverse rotation (left turn) → Operation completed
(Back door CLOSED)
Below 1 V → Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V →
Below 1 V
ACT- (B9-14) - Body
ground
L-R - Body ground
Back door OPEN → NOT COMPLETELY CLOSED →
Monitor in normal rotation (Right turn) → Motor in
reverse rotation (left turn) → Operation completed
(Back door CLOSED)
Below 1 V → Below 1 V →
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may
malfunction.
TD
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–1
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
THEFT DETERRENT
SECURITIES
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- ALT FUSE
- AM1 FUSE
- ECU-B FUSE
SECURITY HORN
ASSEMBLY
HAZARD
WARNING
LIGHT
TD
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
B120216E04
TD–2
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
THEFT WARNING ECU
ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR W/ MOTOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY RH
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
- FRONT DOOR LOCK
INTERIOR
LIGHT
- SECURITY INDICATOR
IGNITION OR STARTER
SWITCH
FRONT COURTESY SWITCH RH
REAR DOOR W/ MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
UN-LOCK WARNING
SWITCH
- REAR DOOR LOCK
REAR COURTESY
SWITCH RH
HAZARD
WARNING
LIGHT
INSTRUMENT PANEL
J/B ASSEMBLY
- IG1 RELAY
- DOOR FUSE
- ECU-IG FUSE
TD
REAR COURTESY
SWITCH LH
- BODY ECU
W/ MOTOR BACK DOOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY
- BACK DOOR LOCK
FRONT DOOR W/ MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
- FRONT DOOR LOCK
FRONT COURTESY
SWITCH LH
REAR DOOR W/ MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
MULTIPLEX NETWORK
BACK DOOR ECU
- REAR DOOR LOCK
- BACK DOOR ECU
B120217E03
TD–20
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The engine hood courtesy switch is built in the engine hood lock assembly. The switch turns on when the
engine hood is opened and turns off when the engine hood is closed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
E3
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
4
6
IC3
1
34
DSWH
EB
C
B134206E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ENGINE HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY (ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH)
(a) Remove the courtesy switch from hood lock assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
TD
Free (ON)
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-4
Pushed:
OFF (Lock)
10 kΩ or higher
1-4
Not pushed:
ON (Unlock)
Below 1 Ω
Pushed
(OFF)
NG
B064979E01
OK
REPLACE ENGINE HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
TD–21
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY - ENGINE
HOOD COURTESY SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector and E3 courtesy
switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
Symbol (Tester Connection)
Specified Condition
DSWH (T5-34) - (E3-1)
Below 1 Ω
DSWH (T5-34) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
E3
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B064977E01
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
E3
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
NG
B110538E03
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E3-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TD
TD–28
THEFT DETERRENT – ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY
SWITCH
Free (ON)
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
INSPECTION
1.
Pushed
(OFF)
INSPECT ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
1-2
B064979E01
TD
Switch Position
Specified Condition
Free (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the hood lock
assembly.
TD–22
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Security Horn Circuit
DESCRIPTION
During the alarm sounding state, the relay in the ECU turns on and off in a cycle of approximately 0.2
seconds, causing the security horn to sound.
WIRING DIAGRAM
T5 Theft Warning
ECU Assembly
SECU/HORN
3
+B2
FL MAIN
1
Battery
SH-
T1
Security Horn Assembly
B110509E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
TD
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THEFT WARNING ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
Symbol (Tester Connection)
Specified Condition
+B2 (T5-3) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
B063408E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TD–23
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2
INSPECT SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the T1 security horn connector.
(b) Check the operation of the security horn.
Standard
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Horn body
Security horn sounds
NG
REPLACE SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
B070004
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY - SECURITY
HORN ASSEMBLY)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
T1
Security Horn Assembly
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Symbol (Tester Connection)
Specified Condition
SH- (T5-1) - (T1-1)
Below 1 Ω
SH- (T5-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Connector Wire Harness View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
TD
SHB112146E01
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
TD–29
THEFT DETERRENT – SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Check operation of the horn.
Standard
Measurement Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
B070004
Battery negative (-) → Horn body
Specified Condition
Horn sounds
If the result is not as specified, replace the security
horn assembly.
TD
TD–24
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Ignition Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, battery positive voltage is applied to terminal IG of
the ECU. When battery positive voltage is applied to terminal IG of the ECU while the theft deterrent
system is operating, the warning stops.
WIRING DIAGRAM
I18
Ignition Switch Assembly
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
ECU-IG
2 AM1
IG1 4
10
T5
IG
AM1
2
1
ALT
1
2
Battery
B139460E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSES (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the instrument panel J/B.
(b) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
TD
NG
REPLACE FUSES
OK
2
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the I18 switch connector.
TD–25
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
I18
Ignition Switch Assembly
Tester Connection
Switch Position
Specified Condition
2-4
ON
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE IGNITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
No Pin
ACC
LOCK
ON
START
B110511E06
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
B063408E01
Symbol (Tester Connection)
Specified Condition
IG (T5-10) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TD
TD–26
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Security Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Even in the disarming state, the security indicator light flashes due to a signal output from the immobiliser
system. The security indicator light always flashes by receiving a signal from the immobiliser system at
any time in the armed state.
The theft warning ECU assembly causes the security indicator light to light up or blink only during the
customizing function mode or the add mode of the transmitter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
D3
Air Conditioning Control Assembly
(Security Indicator Light)
7
GND
SIND
12
25
T5
IND
B139455E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TD
1
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY (SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT)
(a) Disconnect the A/C control connector.
(b) Connect 3 dry batteries of 1.5 V in series.
(c) Apply 4.5 V positive voltage between each terminal of
the A/C control, and check the lighting condition of the
security indicator light.
Result
D3 A/C Control Assembly
(Security Indicator Light)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
B063397E01
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
SIND (D3-12) - GND (D3-7)
Lights up
NOTICE:
• If the positive (+) lead and the negative (-) lead are
incorrectly connected, the security indicator light
does not light up.
• Voltage of more than 4.5 V will damage the
security indicator light.
TD–27
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
• If the voltage is too low, the security indicator
light does not light up.
NG
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (THEFT WARNING ECU - SECURITY INDICATOR
LIGHT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU and D3 A/C control connectors.
(b) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
IND (T5-25) - SIND (D3-12)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
D3
A/C Control Assembly
(Security Indicator Light)
B065620E01
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D3 A/C control connector.
(b) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
D3 A/C Control Assembly
(Security Indicator Light)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
SIND (D3-12) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
B065619E01
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TD
TD–28
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the theft warning ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
Short Pin
ECU-B
2
1
2
1
2
29
+B1
E
Battery
B139461E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-B)
(a) Remove the ECU-B fuse from the engine room J/B.
(b) Measure the resistance.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
TD
NG
OK
REPLACE FUSE
TD–29
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Remove the T5 ECU assembly with the connector still
connected.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
B063408E01
Symbol (Tester Connection)
Specified Condition
+B1 (T5-2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
Symbol (Tester Connection)
Specified Condition
E (T5-29) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
B063408E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
TD
EI–4
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
REGISTRATION
1.
DESCRIPTION OF CODE REGISTRATION
HINT:
The key has 2 codes: The key code (immobiliser code)
and the wireless code. Both of these codes need to be
registered. Refer to page for the wireless code
registration procedures.
(a) When adding master keys or sub keys (Additional
registration):
(1) Register key code (immobiliser code) in the
transponder key ECU.
Target ECU
See Procedure
Transponder key ECU
Procedure "A"
(b) When replacing the transponder key ECU (New
registration):
(1) Register the key code (immobiliser code) in the
transponder key ECU.
Target ECU
See Procedure
Transponder key ECU
Procedure "B"
(2) Register the ECU COMMUNICATION ID
between the ECM and the transponder key
ECU.
Target ECU
See Procedure
Transponder key ECU
Procedure "C"
(c) When replacing the ECM:
(1) Register the ECU COMMUNICATION ID
between the ECM and the transponder key
ECU.
Target ECU
See Procedure
Transponder key ECU
Procedure "C"
2.
EI
KEY REGISTRATION
(a) Automatic registration (Procedure "B"):
The new registration of the key codes (immobiliser
codes) is made automatically.
HINT:
• When installing a new transponder key ECU, the
key codes (immobiliser codes) must be
registered.
• A new transponder key ECU starts in the
automatic key code registration mode. In this
mode, a maximum of 4 key codes for 3 master
keys and 1 sub key can be registered. Since the
transponder key ECU can distinguish types of
keys, any registration order is acceptable.
Automatic Key Code Registration (New Registration)
Procedure
Security Indicator Condition
1. Start (Procedure "D")
Blinking occurs until the first key is inserted.
2. Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder.
ON
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Procedure
3. Registration begins.
HINT:
The registration will be completed approx. 1 sec. after the key is
inserted.
4. Remove the key.
5. Register another key ?
Yes: Go to procedure "D"
No: Go to procedure "E"
EI–5
Security Indicator Condition
OFF
HINT:
Approx. 1 sec.
ON
HINT:
When the maximum number of the key codes is registered, the
security indicator remains off until the last key registered is removed.
After it is removed, the security indicator starts blinking.
6. End (Procedure "E")
HINT:
• When no key is inserted in the key cylinder while
the system is in automatic key code registration
mode, the security indicator remains on.
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and the key is pulled out, the security
indicator blinks continuously.
• If the key code registration has failed in the
automatic key code registration mode, code 2-1
will be output from the security indicator. Trying
to register an already registered key will cause
code 2-2 to be output when the key is inserted. If
the number of registered key codes exceeds the
limit, code 2-3 will be output from the security
indicator. The output details are shown below.
EI
EI–6
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Security Indicator:
0.2 sec.
ON
Normal (Immobiliser
system is operating
normally)
OFF
1.8 sec.
0.25 sec.
1 sec.
ON
Code 2 - 1
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.25 sec.
1 sec.
ON
Code 2 - 2
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.25 sec.
1 sec.
EI
ON
Code 2 - 3
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
B111593E14
EI–7
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(b) Finish the automatic key code registration mode.
The automatic key code registration mode can be
forced to end, when at least 1 key code (immobiliser
code) for the master key has been registered.
(1) Turn the ignition switch on and off 5 times
within 10 seconds using the already registered
master key.
3.
REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL KEY
(a) Additional registration (Procedure "A"):
Register an additional key by using the intelligent
tester.
HINT:
• A maximum of 5 key codes and 3 sub key codes
can be registered.
• Registration mode will end if any step is not
completed within the specified time.
• When the ignition cylinder or the key cylinder set
is replaced, remove the transmitter module from
the original master key. Then install this
transmitter module to a new key and use it as
master key. If necessary, use this master key to
register other keys.
NOTICE:
When only the ignition key cylinder has been
replaced, you can lock or unlock doors by
wireless operation using the new key with built
in transmitter but not by inserting it in the door
key cylinder. Therefore, keep the original key for
door lock or unlock operation in order to avoid
malfunctions caused by a dead transmitter
battery in the new key.
Additional Registration
Procedure
Time
(Completion of operation)
Security Indicator Condition
-
Indicator blinks until the first key is inserted.
1. Start
2. Insert the already registered master-key in
the ignition key cylinder and turn the ignition
switch on.
3. Intelligent tester operation
(1) Select IMMOBILISER
(2) Select ID UTILITY
(3) Select IMMOB CODE REG
HINT:
After completing the above operation,
proceed to the next step in accordance with
the prompts on the tester screen.
4. Remove the master key.
5. Insert the key to be registered in the
ignition key cylinder.
6. After 60 sec. the key is registered.
HINT:
The security indicator goes off.
7. Next
8. End
EI
Within 120 sec.
OFF
Within 20 sec. of the instruction on the tester
Within 10 sec.
-
ON
Blinking
OFF
EI–8
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
NOTICE:
If the key code registration has failed in
automatic key code registration mode, code 2-1
will be output from the security indicator. Trying
to register an already registered key will cause
code 2-2 to be output when the key is inserted. If
the number of registered key codes exceeds the
limit, code 2-3 will be output from the security
indicator. The output details are shown in
procedure "B".
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for key code
registration is shown above. For detailed
information, please refer to the screen of the
intelligent tester.
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and the key is pulled out, the security
indicator will blink.
4.
ERASURE OF KEY CODE
(a) Erase key codes by using the intelligent tester.
HINT:
• All key codes will be erased except for the
master-key which is used for erasing the key
codes. In order to use a key for which the code
has been erased, it is necessary to register the
key code again.
• The registration operation will be cancelled if any
step is not completed within the specified time.
Erasing Key Code
Procedure
Time
(Operation Completion Time)
Security Indicator Condition
-
Indicator blinks until the first key is inserted.
Within 120 sec.
OFF
Within 10 sec. of the instruction on the tester
ON for 1 sec. then OFF
-
Blinking
1. Start
2. Insert the already registered master-key in
the ignition key cylinder and turn the ignition
switch on.
EI
3. Intelligent tester operation
(1) Select IMMOBILISER
(2) Select ID UTILITY
(3) Select IMMOB CODE ERA
HINT:
After completing the above operation,
proceed to the next step in accordance with
the prompts on the tester screen.
4. Remove the master key.
5. Next
6. End
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for key code
registration is shown above. For detailed
information, please refer to the screen of the
intelligent tester.
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and the key is pulled out, the security
indicator will blink.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
5.
EI–9
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
• The ECU communication ID should be registered
when the transponder key ECU and/or the ECM is
replaced in order to match it to the ECM
COMMUNICATION ID.
• The SFI system cannot be started unless the ECM
COMMUNICATION ID matches.
(a) ECU communication ID registration (Procedure
"C"):
Register the ECU COMMUNICATION ID, after the
transponder key ECU and/or the ECM is replaced
turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of
the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and
leave it as is for 30 minutes.
(3) Check that the engine starts.
EI
EI–10
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Symptom
Engine does not start
EI
Suspected area
See page
1. Key (Transponder chip malfunction)
EI-24
2. Key (Unmatched encryption code)
EI-25
3. Key (Unmatched key code)
EI-26
4. Key (No communication in immobiliser system)
EI-27
5. Key (Communication malfunction)
EI-31
6. Transponder key amplifier (Antenna coil open / short)
EI-21
7. Transponder key amplifier (No communication in
immobiliser system)
EI-27
8. Transponder key amplifier (Communication malfunction)
EI-31
9. Transponder key ECU assembly (Key unlock warning
switch malfunction)
EI-18
10. Transponder key ECU assembly (Antenna coil open /
short)
EI-21
11. Transponder key ECU assembly (No communication in
immobiliser system)
EI-27
12. Transponder key ECU assembly (Communication
malfunction)
EI-31
13. Transponder key ECU assembly (Engine immobiliser
system malfunction)
EI-34
EI–11
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
I17
B065593E24
(a) Disconnect the I17 amplifier connector and measure
the resistance between the terminal of the wire
harness side connector and body ground.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND (I17-7) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
L - Body ground
Ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Always
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the I17 amplifier connector and measure
the resistance and voltage of each terminal of the
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
VC5 (I17-1) - GND (I17-7)
CODE (I17-4) - GND (I177)
TXCT (I17-5) - GND (I177)
GND (I17-7) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
GR-B - L
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
Demodulated signal of key
code date
LG-R - L
Key code output signal
L - Body ground
Specified Condition
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Power source
P-L
Condition
Ground
Below 1 V
4.6 to 5.4 V
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
Below 1 V
Waveform 1
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
Below 1 V
Waveform 2
Below 1 Ω
Always
If the result is not as specified, the amplifier may
have a malfunction.
(c) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
(1) Waveform 1 (Reference):
Terminal
B055023
CODE - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Condition
Key is in ignition key cylinder
EI
EI–12
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(2) Waveform 2 (Reference):
Terminal
TXCT - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Condition
Key is in ignition key cylinder
2.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
B055024
T8
B111613E12
(a) Disconnect the T8 ECU connector and measure the
resistance and voltage between each terminal of the
wire harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
+B (T8-1) - GND (T8-14)
IG (T8-2) - GND (T8-14)
KSW (T8-10) - GND (T814)
Wiring Color
W-R - W-B
B-O - W-B
G-Y - W-B
Terminal Description
Battery
Ignition switch
Unlock warning switch
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the T8 ECU connector and measure the
voltage of each terminal of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
EI
AGND (T8-13) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
L - Body ground
KSW (T8-10) - GND (T814)
G-Y - W-B
VC5 (T8-8) - AGND (T813)
GR-B - W
TXCT (T8-12) - AGND
(T8-13)
CODE (T8-11) - AGND
(T8-13)
LG-R - W
P-G - W
Terminal Description
Ground
Unlock warning switch
Power source
Transponder key amplifier
communication signal
Transponder key amplifier
ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
10 to 14 V
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
Below 1 V
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
4.6 to 5.4 V
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
Below 1 V
Waveform 1
Below 1 V
Waveform 2
EI–13
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
EFIO (T8-6) - GND (T814)
EFII (T8-7) - GND (T8-14)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
W-R - W-B
ECM output signal
L-R - W-B
ECM input signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
Waveform 3
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
Waveform 4
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
(c) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
(1) Wave form 1 (Reference):
Terminal
TXCT - AGND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Condition
Key is in ignition key cylinder
B055023
(2) Wave form 2 (Reference):
Terminal
CODE - AGND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Condition
Key is in ignition key cylinder
B055024
(3) Wave form 3 (Reference):
Terminal
EFIO - GND
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 5 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
EI
B052547
(4) Wave form 4 (Reference):
B052548
Terminal
EFII - GND
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 5 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
EI–14
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
3.
E4
E5
CHECK ECM
E6
E7
E8
B050745E06
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector and measure the
resistance between the terminal of the wire harness
side connector and body ground.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
E1 (E6-1) - Body ground
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Always
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the E6 ECM. Measure the voltage
between each terminal of the connector according
to the value(s) in the table below.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IMI (E7-16) - E1 (E6-1)
W-R - W-B
Transponder key ECU
input signal
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
Waveform 1
IMO (E7-15) - E1 (E6-1)
L-R - W-B
Transponder key ECU
output signal
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
Waveform 2
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
(1) Waveform 1 (Reference):
Terminal
IMI - E1
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 5 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
EI
B052547
(2) Waveform 2 (Reference):
B052548
Terminal
IMO - E1
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 5 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
EI–15
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
2.
3.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
DESCRIPTION
The ECU stores trouble codes when trouble occurs on
the vehicle.
The diagnostic system allows for reading of the trouble
codes from the DLC3.
Use the intelligent tester to check and solve the problem.
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 10 V, replace the battery
before proceed to the next step.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle's ECU uses ISO 9141-2 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement
of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches
the ISO 9141-2 format.
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
G039021E04
(b) Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch to the ON
position and attempt to use the intelligent tester. If
the screen displays a communication error
message, a problem exists in the vehicle side or
tester side.
HINT:
• If communication is normal when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the tool
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
EI
EI–16
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
DLC3
CAN VIM
G039021E04
2.
EI
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the Controller Area
Network Vehicle Interface Module (CAN VIM). Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR THE DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
EI–1
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
ENGINE IMMOBILISER
SECURITIES
PARTS LOCATION
SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
ECM
UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
EI
B139187E01
EI–2
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the engine immobiliser
system.
• The intelligent tester should be used in steps 4, 5 and 7.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
NEXT
3
CRANK ENGINE FOR MORE THAN 10 SECONDS
NEXT
4
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC (SFI system
and engine immobiliser system) by simulating the
original activity that the DTC suggested.
(1) If the DTC does not reoccur, proceed to A.
(2) If the DTC (SFI system) reoccurs, proceed to B.
(3) If the DTC (engine immobiliser system) reoccurs,
proceed to C.
EI
B
Go to SFI SYSTEM
C
Go to step 8
A
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER ((IMMOBILISER ECU (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY) (SWITCH CONDITION))
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
EI–3
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(c) Select the item KEY SW in the DATA LIST and read its
value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Item
KEY SW
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Unlock warning switch signal /
ON or OFF
NG
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key
cylinder
-
Go to DTC B2780
OK
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) If the fault is not listed on the problem symptoms table,
proceed to A.
(b) If the fault is listed on the problem symptoms table,
proceed to B.
B
Go to step 8
A
7
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Inspection with the intelligent tester (DATA LIST).
(b) Inspection with the intelligent tester (ACTIVE TEST).
(c) Terminals of ECU (See page EI-10).
NEXT
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
9
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
EI
EI–17
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the DATA LIST displayed on the intelligent tester,
you can read the value of the switch, sensor, actuator,
etc. without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as
the first step in troubleshooting is one way to shorten the
labor time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Transponder key ECU
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Unlock warning switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key
cylinder
-
Ignition switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Ignition switch on
OFF: Ignition switch off
-
Immobiliser system status / SET
or UNSET
UNSET: Ignition switch on
SET: Without key
-
RESPONSE
Transponder chip data / NG or
OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
-
FRAME
Transponder chip data / NG or
OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
-
SERIAL NUMBER
Transponder chip data / NG or
OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
-
ENCRYPT CODE
Transponder chip data / NG or
OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
-
STATUS
Transponder chip data / NG or
OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
-
BCC
Transponder chip data / NG or
OK
NG: Incorrect data being sent.
OK: Correct data being sent.
-
SUB KEY
Sub key code signal / NOMATH
or MATCH
NOMATCH: Non matching sub
key code is sent.
MATCH: Sub key code is sent.
-
Master key code signal /
NOMATH or MATCH
NOMATCH: Non matching
master key code is sent.
MATCH: Master key code is sent.
-
REGIST SUB CODE
Number of registered sub key /
min. 0, max. 15
Number of registered sub key.
-
REGIST MAS CODE
Number of registered master key
/ min. 0, max. 15
Number of registered master key.
-
Memory space for key codes
registration / NOT FUL or FULL
NOT FUL: More key code
registration possible.
FULL: No more key code
registration possible.
-
Power source / BRAKE or
NORMAL
BRAKE: Power source open.
NORMAL: Power source normal.
-
Antenna coil condition / NORMAL
or FAIL
NORMAL: Antenna coil is normal.
FAIL: Antenna coil is
malfunctioning.
-
Item
KEY SW
IG SW
IMMOBILISER
MASTER KEY
REG CODE SPAC
+B
ANTENNA COIL
EI
EI–18
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows the relay, VSV, actuator, etc. to operate without
removing any parts . Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
the first step of troubleshooting is one way to shorten
labor time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Turn the tester ON.
(d) Perform the ACTIVE TEST to the display on the
tester.
Transponder key ECU
EI
Item
Test Details
SECURITY INDIC
Turn security indicator ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
-
EI–19
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the circuit listed for that code. For details of each code, turn
the page mentioned below the "DTC No" in the DTC chart.
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B2780
Push Switch / Key Unlock
Warning Switch Malfunction
1. Unlock warning switch
assembly
2. Wire harness
3. Transponder key ECU
assembly
EI-18
B2784
Antenna Coil Open / Short
1. Transponder key amplifier
2. Wire harness
3. Transponder key ECU
assembly
EI-21
B2793
Transponder Chip Malfunction
Key
EI-24
B2794
Unmatched Encryption Code
Key
EI-25
B2795
Unmatched Key Code
Key
EI-26
B2796
No Communication in Immobiliser
System
1. Key
2. Transponder key amplifier
3. Wire harness
4. Transponder key ECU
assembly
EI-27
B2797
Communication Malfunction No. 1
1. Key
2. Transponder key amplifier
3. Wire harness
4. Transponder key ECU
assembly
EI-31
B2798
Communication Malfunction No. 2
1. Key
2. Transponder key amplifier
3. Wire harness
4. Transponder key ECU
assembly
EI-27
ECM DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
B2799
Detection Item
Engine Immobiliser System
Trouble Area
1. Wire harness
2. Transponder key ECU
assembly
3. ECM
See page
EI-34
NOTICE:
The DTC for the immobiliser system is specified above. If
other codes are output, check the DTC chart for the SFI
system.
EI
EI–20
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
Push Switch / Key Unlock Warning Switch Malfunction
B2780
DESCRIPTION
This DTC will be output if the transponder key ECU does not detect that the unlock warning switch is on
even when the ignition switch is on (Under the normal conditions, the unlock warning switch is on when
the ignition switch is on).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Unlock warning switch on is not detected when ignition
switch is on
B2780
•
•
•
Unlock warning switch assembly
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
T8
Transponder Key
ECU Assembly
K3
Unlock Warning
Switch Assembly
J/C
W-B
1
2
G-Y
C
J15
B
J14
G-Y
10
KSW
A
J15
J/C
A
W-B
A
EI
J5
J/C
IG
B144970E01
EI–21
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Select KEY SW in the DATA LIST and read the value
displayed on the intelligent tester.
Transponder key ECU
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY SW
Unlock warning switch signal /ON
or OFF
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key
cylinder
-
OK:
ON (Key is in ignition key cylinder) appears on the
screen
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
INSPECT UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the unlock warning switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Unlock Warning Switch Assembly
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Free
1-2
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Switch pushed (Key
set)
Below 1 Ω
Switch free (Key
removed)
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed
NG
B111614E01
OK
REPLACE UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
EI
EI–22
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY - UNLOCK
WARNING SW ASSEMBLY)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Disconnect the T8 ECU and K3 switch connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T8-10 (KSW) - K3-2
Below 1 Ω
T8-10 (KSW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T8
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
KSW
Unlock Warning Switch Assembly
K3
B111594E10
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (UNLOCK WARNING SW ASSEMBLY - BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
K3-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
K3
EI
NG
Unlock Warning Switch Assembly
B111599E06
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
EI–23
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2784
Antenna Coil Open / Short
DESCRIPTION
The transponder key coil is built into the transponder key amplifier and receives a key code signal from
the transponder chip in the key. This signal is amplified by the amplifier, and output to the transponder key
ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B2784
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Antenna coil open/short
Transponder key amplifier
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
T8
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
Amplifier
ANT1
Coil
VC5
1
GR-B
8
CODE
4
P-G
11
TXCT
5
LG-R
12
GND
7
L
13
ANT2
VC5
CODE
TXCT
AGND
B111588E15
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
EI
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Select ANTENNA COIL in the DATA LIST and read the
value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Transponder key ECU
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
ANTENNA COIL
Antenna coil condition /NORMAL
or FAIL
Normal Condition
NORMAL: Antenna coil is
normal.
FAIL: Antenna coil is
malfunctioning.
Diagnostic Note
-
EI–24
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
OK:
NORMAL (Antenna coil is normal) appears on the
screen.
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Disconnect the T8 ECU and I17 switch connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T8-8 (VC5) - I17-1 (VC5)
T8
T8-11 (CODE) - I17-4 (CODE)
Below 1 Ω
T8-12 (TXCT) - I17-5 (TXCT)
T8-13 (AGND) - I17-7 (GND)
VC5 CODE TXCT AGND
T8-8 (VC5) - Body ground
T8-11 (CODE) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T8-12 (TXCT) - Body ground
T8-13 (AGND) - Body ground
Transponder Key Amplifier
NG
I17
VC5
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
GND
CODE TXCT
B111591E12
OK
3
EI
INSPECT TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
Wire Harness Side Connector Rear View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Reconnect the T8 ECU and I17 amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
T8-8 (VC5) - Body
ground
T8
AGND
Condition
Specified Condition
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
Below 1 V
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
4.6 to 5.4 V
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
VC5
B111616E16
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T8-13 (AGND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
NG
EI–25
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
EI
EI–26
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2793
Transponder Chip Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a malfunction is found in the key during the key code registration or the key code
is not registered normally. Replace the key when the key code registration is not performed normally and
this DTC is detected.
DTC No.
B2793
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Transponder chip malfunction
Key
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC OUTPUT
(a) Delete the DTC (See page EI-15).
(b) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder.
(c) Check that no code is output.
OK:
No DTC is output.
OK
END
NG
2
RE-REGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (See page EI-15).
(b) Re-register the key (See page EI-3) and insert this key
into the ignition key cylinder. Check that the engine starts
with the key.
OK:
The engine starts.
OK
NG
EI
REPLACE KEY
END
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2794
EI–27
Unmatched Encryption Code
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with an incomplete key code is inserted into the ignition key cylinder.
DTC No.
B2794
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Key with incomplete key code inserted
Key
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RE-REGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (See page EI-15).
(b) Re-register the key (See page EI-3) and insert this key
into the ignition key cylinder. Check that the engine starts
with this key.
OK:
The engine starts.
OK
END
NG
REPLACE KEY
EI
EI–28
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2795
Unmatched Key Code
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with a code that has not been registered in the ECU is inserted into the
ignition key cylinder.
DTC No.
B2795
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Key with unregistered key code is inserted.
Key
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RE-REGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (See page EI-15).
(b) Re-register the key (See page EI-3) and insert key into
the ignition key cylinder. Check that the engine starts
with this key.
OK:
The engine starts.
OK
NG
REPLACE KEY
EI
END
EI–29
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2796
No Communication in Immobiliser System
DTC
B2798
Communication Malfunction No. 2
DESCRIPTION
These codes are stored in the memory when a key that does not have a transponder chip is inserted or if
communication between the key and transponder key ECU is impossible.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B2796
B2798
Trouble Area
No communication
•
•
•
•
Key
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assembly
Communication error
•
•
•
•
Key
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
T8
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
Amplifier
ANT1
Coil
VC5
1
GR-B
8
CODE
4
P-G
11
TXCT
5
LG-R
12
GND
7
L
13
ANT2
VC5
CODE
TXCT
AGND
B111588E16
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
intelligent tester main switch on.
EI
EI–30
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(c) Select IMMOBILISER in the DATA LIST and read the
value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Transponder key ECU
Item
IMMOBILISER
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Immobiliser system status / SET
or UNSET
Normal Condition
UNSET: Ignition switch on
SET: Without key
Diagnostic Note
-
OK:
UNSET (Ignition switch on) appears on the screen.
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
CHECK KEYS
(a) Insert the vehicle's other key into the ignition key
cylinder.
(b) Check that the engine starts with this key.
OK:
The engine starts.
OK
RE-REGISTER OR REPLACE KEY
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Select ANTENNA COIL in the DATA LIST and read the
value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Transponder key ECU
EI
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ANTENNA COIL
Antenna coil condition /NORMAL
or FAIL
NORMAL: Antenna coil is normal.
FAIL: Antenna coil is
malfunctioning.
-
OK:
NORMAL (Antenna coil is normal) appears on the
screen.
OK
NG
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
EI–31
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Disconnect the T8 ECU and I17 amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T8-8 (VC5) - I17-1 (VC5)
T8
T8-11 (CODE) - I17-4 (CODE)
Below 1 Ω
T8-12 (TXCT) - I17-5 (TXCT)
T8-13 (AGND) - I17-7 (GND)
VC5 CODE TXCT AGND
T8-8 (VC5) - Body ground
T8-11 (CODE) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T8-12 (TXCT) - Body ground
T8-13 (AGND) - Body ground
Transponder Key Amplifier
NG
I17
VC5
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
GND
CODE TXCT
B111591E13
OK
5
INSPECT TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
Wire Harness Side Connector Rear View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Reconnect the T8 ECU and I17 amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
T8-9 (VC5) - Body
ground
T8
AGND
Specified Condition
Below 1 V
Key is in ignition key
cylinder
4.6 to 5.4 V
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
VC5
B111616E17
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T8-13 (AGND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
Condition
No key is in ignition key
cylinder
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
EI
EI–32
6
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
(a) After replacing the transponder key amplifier with a
normally functioning transponder key amplifier, check
that the engine starts.
OK:
The engine starts.
NG
OK
END
EI
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
EI–33
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2797
Communication Malfunction No. 1
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when an error occurs in normal communication.
HINT:
Some noise found in the communication line.
DTC No.
B2797
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Keys are positioned too close to each other, or noise
occurred in communication line.
•
•
•
•
Key
Transponder key amplifier
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
I17
Transponder Key Amplifier
CODE
T8
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
4
10
P-G
CODE
B145170E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK KEY
(a) Check whether the ignition key being used is near other
ignition keys, as shown in the illustration. Also, check
whether the key ring is in contact with the key grip.
Result
Example:
Result
Key is near other keys and/or key ring is in contact
with key grip.
A
Key is not near other keys and / or key ring is not in
contact with key grip.
B
B111583E01
B
Go to step 3
A
2
Proceed to
CHECK DTC OUTPUT
(a) Delete the DTC (See page EI-15).
EI
EI–34
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(b) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder.
(c) Check that no code is output.
OK:
No DTC is output.
OK
END
NG
3
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
Wire Harness Side Connector Rear View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Using an oscilloscope or the intelligent tester, check the
waveform between the terminals of the I17 amplifier and
T8 ECU connectors.
(b) Check that no noise is included in the waveform (an
example of noise is shown on the left).
Result
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I17-4 (CODE) - T8-11 (CODE)
No noise is present
T8
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Condition
Key inserted into ignition key cylinder.
CODE
NG
Transponder Key Amplifier
I17
CODE
EI
Noise
B111615E12
OK
FIND CAUSE OF NOISE AND REMOVE IT
EI–35
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - TRANSPONDER KEY
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Disconnect the T8 ECU and I17 amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T8-10 (CODE) - I17-4 (CODE)
Below 1 Ω
T8
NG
CODE
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Transponder Key Amplifier
I17
CODE
B111591E14
OK
5
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
(a) After replacing the transponder key amplifier with a
normally functioning transponder key amplifier, check
that the engine starts.
OK:
The engine starts.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ASSEMBLY
EI
EI–36
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DTC
B2799
Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the ECM detects errors in communication between the transponder key ECU
and the ECM, or in the communication lines. This DTC is also output when an engine start is attempted
while the ECU communication ID between the transponder key ECU and the ECM are different. Before
troubleshooting for this DTC, make sure that there is no DTC detected in the transponder key ECU. If
there is key code-related DTC detected in the transponder key ECU, repair it first.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
B2799
•
Trouble Area
Error in communication between ECM and
transponder key ECU, and in communication line
Communication ID is different during communication
with transponder key ECU
•
•
•
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assembly
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T8
Transponder Key
ECU Assembly
ECM
16
IMI
E7
15
IMO
E7
W-R
6
LR
7
EFIO
EFII
B118496E08
EI
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RE-REGISTER ECU COMMUNICATION ID
(a) Re-register the ECU communication ID (See page EI-3)
between the transponder key ECU assembly and ECM.
(b) Check that the engine starts.
OK:
The engine starts.
OK
NG
END
EI–37
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY - ECM)
Wire Harness Side Connector Front View:
Transponder Key ECU Assembly
(a) Disconnect the T8 ECU and E7 ECM connectors.
(b) Check the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
T8-6 (EFIO) - E7-16 (IMI)
T8
T8-7 (EFII) - E7-15 (IMO)
T8-6 (EFIO) - Body ground
T8-7 (EFII) - Body ground
EFIO
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
EFII
NG
ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
E7
IMO
IMI
B066229E10
OK
3
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
(a) After replacing the transponder key ECU assembly with
a normally functioning transponder key ECU assembly,
check that the engine starts.
OK:
The engine starts.
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
EI
END
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–3
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
This system is controlled by the ECM, and is activated by
the throttle position sensor and motor. The ECM controls
the following functions: ON-OFF, - (COAST)/SET, +
(ACCEL)/RES (RESUME), CANCEL, vehicle speed
operation, motor output control, and overdrive control.
• The ECM compares the driving vehicle speed from
the speed sensor with the stored vehicle speed set
through the cruise control main switch. The ECM
instructs the throttle valve motor of the throttle body
assembly to close the valve when the driving speed is
greater than the stored speed, and instructs it to open
the valve when the driving speed is less than the
stored speed.
• The ECM receives signals such as ON-OFF, (COAST)/SET, + (ACCEL)/RES (RESUME), and
CANCEL from the cruise control main switch and
executes the command.
• The ECM illuminates the combination meter's
CRUISE main indicator light when it receives a cruise
control main switch ON signal.
• The ECM cancels the cruise control system when the
brake pedal is depressed and the ECM receives a
stop light switch signal.
• The ECM cancels the cruise control system when the
clutch pedal is depressed and the ECM receives a
clutch switch signal.
LIMIT CONTROL
(a) Low speed limit
The lowest possible limit of the speed setting range
is set at approximately 40 km/h (25 mph). The
cruise control system cannot be set when the
driving vehicle speed is below the low speed limit.
Cruise control operation will be automatically
canceled.
(b) High speed limit
The highest possible limit of the speed setting range
is set at approximately 200 km/h (125 mph). The
cruise control system cannot be set when the
driving vehicle speed is over the high speed limit.
Also, + (ACCEL)/RES (RESUME) cannot be used to
increase speed beyond the high speed limit.
CC
CC–4
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
3.
CC
OPERATION OF CRUISE CONTROL
The cruise control main switch operates 7 functions:
SET, - (COAST), TAP-DOWN, RES (RESUME), +
(ACCEL), TAP-UP, and CANCEL. The SET, TAP-DOWN,
and - (COAST) functions, and the RES (RESUME), TAPUP, and + (ACCEL) functions are operated with the
same switch. The cruise control main switch is an
automatic return type switch which turns on only while
operating it in the direction of each arrow and turns off
after releasing it.
(a) SET CONTROL
Vehicle speed is stored and constant speed control
is maintained when pushing the cruise control main
switch to - (COAST)/SET while driving with the main
switch on (the CRUISE main indicator light is on),
and the vehicle speed is within the set speed range
(between the low and high speed limits).
(b) - (COAST) CONTROL
When the cruise control main switch is set to (COST)/SET and held in that position while the
cruise control system is operating, the ECM sends a
"throttle valve opening angle 0°" demand signal to
the cruise control system. Then the vehicle speed,
when the cruise control main switch is released, is
stored and maintained.
HINT:
An actual throttle valve opening angle of 0° is not
possible due to the idle speed control, etc.
(c) TAP-DOWN CONTROL
When tapping down the cruise control main switch
to - (COAST)/SET (for approximately 0.6 seconds)
while the cruise control system is in operation, the
stored vehicle speed decreases each time by
approximately 1.6 km/h (1.0 mph). When the cruise
control main switch is released from - (COAST)/SET
and the difference between the driving and stored
vehicle speed is more than 5 km/h (3 mph), the
driving vehicle speed is stored and constant speed
control is maintained.
(d) ACCELERATION CONTROL
The throttle valve motor of the throttle body
assembly is instructed by the ECM to open the
throttle valve when + (ACCEL)/RES (RESUME) on
the cruise control main switch is pressed and held
while the cruise control system is in operation.
When the cruise control main switch is released
from + (ACCEL)/RES (RESUME), the vehicle speed
is stored and the vehicle is controlled at a constant
speed.
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
4.
CC–5
(e) TAP-UP CONTROL
When tapping up the cruise control main switch to +
(ACCEL)/RES (RESUME) (for approximately 0.6
seconds) while the cruise control system is in
operation, the stored vehicle speed increases each
time by approximately 1.6 km/h (1.0 mph). However,
when the difference between the driving and the
stored vehicle speed is more than 5 km/h
(approximately 3.1 mph), the stored vehicle speed
will not be changed.
(f) RESUME CONTROL
If cruise control operation was canceled with the
stop light switch or the CANCEL switch, and if
driving speed is within the limit range, pushing the
cruise control main switch to + (ACCEL)/RES
(RESUME) restores vehicle speed memorized at
the time of cancellation, and maintains constant
speed control.
(g) MANUAL CANCEL CONTROL
Performing any of the following cancels the cruise
control system while in operation (the stored vehicle
speed in the ECM is maintained).
• Depressing the brake pedal
• Depressing the clutch pedal
• The shift lever is moved from the D to the N
position.
• Pushing the cruise control main switch to
CANCEL
• Turning the cruise control main switch off (the
stored vehicle speed in the ECM is not
maintained).
AUTO CANCEL (FAIL-SAFE)
This system has an automatic cancellation function (failsafe) (See page CC-12).
CC
CC–6
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use the following procedures to troubleshoot the cruise
control system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
NEXT
3
DTC CHECK AND CLEAR*
Refer to the DTC CHECK / CLEAR (See page CC-12).
NEXT
4
DTC CHECK (OTHER THAN MPX AND CAN SYSTEM DTC)*
Result
A
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
GO TO STEP 6
B
5
DTC CHART
Refer to the DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (See
page CC-14).
CC
NEXT
GO TO STEP 9
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
Symptom occurs
A
CC–7
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
A
Result
Proceed to
Symptom does not occur
B
GO TO STEP 8
B
7
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
Go to step 6
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Refer to the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page CC9).
NEXT
9
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
10
TERMINALS OF ECM
Refer to TERMINALS OF ECM (See page CC-10).
NEXT
11
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
12
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
13
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
CC
CC–8
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
ROAD TEST
1.
E107085
E107086
E107085
CC
E107087
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a) Inspect the SET function.
(1) Turn the cruise control main switch on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to (COAST)/SET.
(4) After releasing the switch, check that the vehicle
cruises at the set speed.
(b) Inspect the ACCELERATION function.
(1) Turn the cruise control main switch on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to (COAST)/SET.
(4) Check that vehicle speed increases while the
cruise control main switch is pushed to +
(ACCEL)/RES (RESUME), and that the vehicle
cruises at the newly set speed when the switch
is released.
(5) Push the cruise control main switch to +
(ACCEL)/RES (RESUME) and then release it
immediately. Check that vehicle speed increases
by approximately 1.6 km/h (1.0 mph) (tap-up
control).
(c) Inspect the - (COAST) function.
(1) Turn the cruise control main switch on.
(2) Drive at the required speed between 40 km/h
(25 mph) and 200 km/h (125 mph).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to (COAST)/SET.
(4) Check that vehicle speed decreases while the
cruise control main switch is pushed to (COAST)/SET, and the vehicle cruises at the
newly set speed when the switch is released.
(5) Push the cruise control main switch to (COAST)/SET, and then release it immediately.
Check that vehicle speed decreases by
approximately 1.6 km/h (1.0 mph) (tap-down
control).
(d) Inspect the CANCEL function.
(1) Turn the cruise control main switch on.
(2) Drive at the required speed between 40 km/h
(25 mph) and 200 km/h (125 mph).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to (COAST)/SET.
(4) When performing any one of the following,
check that the cruise control system is canceled
and that the normal driving mode is reset.
• Depressing the brake pedal
• Depressing the clutch pedal
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–9
• The shift lever is moved from the D to the N
position.
• Turning the cruise control main switch off
• Pulling the cruise control main switch to
CANCEL
E107086
(e) Inspect the RES (RESUME) function.
(1) Turn the cruise control main switch on.
(2) Drive at the required speed between 40 km/h
(25 mph) and 200 km/h (125 mph).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to (COAST)/SET.
(4) Cancel the cruise control system by performing
any of the above operations (other than turning
the main switch off).
(5) After pushing the cruise control main switch to +
(ACCEL)/RES (RESUME) at a driving speed of
more than 40 km/h (25 mph), check that the
vehicle resumes the speed set prior to the
cancellation.
CC
CC–10
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Be sure to perform the SYMPTOM SIMULATION procedure
before replacing the ECM . IF these symptoms do not persist,
the cause of the problem may be a poor intermittent electrical
contact (open or short) of a wire harness or connector.
Cruise control system
Symptom
Main switch cannot be turned ON. (Cruise indicator
light in combination meter is not lit.)
Vehicle speed setting cannot be done. (Although
indicator light in combination meter is lit when the main
switch is turned ON, they go off when vehicle speed is
set.)
Setting cannot be done. (Indicator light in combination
meter is lit when the main switch is turned ON and they
remain ON while setting.)
While the vehicle is driving with cruise control, the set
control is canceled. (Indicator light and CRUISE
remain ON.)
Hunting (Speed is not constant.)
Setting cannot be canceled. (When Coast,
Acceleration, Resume, Set speed change and Control
switch are operated.)
CC
DTC is not output, or is output when should not be.
CRUISE MAIN indicator light does not light up.
Suspected Area
See page
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-21
2. CRUISE MAIN indicator light circuit
CC-23
3. Replace ECM
ES-434
4. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-21
2. Replace ECM
ES-434
3. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-21
2. Stop light switch
LI-71
3. PNP switch (A750E)
AT-316
4. PNP switch (A750F)
AT-326
5. Combination meter system
ME-4
6. Replace ECM
ES-434
7. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-21
2. Vehicle speed sensor circuit
-
3. Stop light switch
LI-71
4. CRUISE MAIN indicator light circuit
CC-23
5. PNP switch (A750E)
AT-316
6. PNP switch (A750F)
AT-326
7. Replace ECM
ES-434
8. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. Vehicle speed sensor circuit
-
2. Replace ECM
ES-434
3. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-21
2. Replace ECM
ES-434
3. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. TC and CG terminal circuit
CC-25
2. Replace ECM
ES-434
3. Replace ECM
ES-510
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-21
2. CRUISE MAIN indicator light circuit
CC-23
3. Replace ECM
ES-434
4. Replace ECM
ES-510
CC–11
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECM
1.
E4
CHECK ECM
E6
E5
E7
E8
G035613E20
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
E8-23 (TC) - E6-1 (E1)
P-L - W-B
Ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
E8-23 (TC) - E6-1 (E1)
P-L - W-B
Ground
Ignition switch ON,
Connect terminals TC and
CG of DLC3
Below 2 V
E8-15 (STP) - E6-1 (E1)
G-Y - W-B
Stop light signal
Ignition switch ON,
Depress brake pedal
10 to 14 V
E8-15 (STP) - E6-1 (E1)
G-Y - W-B
Stop light signal
Ignition switch ON,
Release brake pedal
Below 1 V
E7-2 (CCS) - E6-1 (E1)
L-B - W-B
Cruise control main switch
circuit
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
E7-2 (CCS) - E6-1 (E1)
L-B - W-B
Cruise control main switch
circuit
Ignition switch ON,
CANCEL switch hold ON
6.0 to 10.1 V
E7-2 (CCS) - E6-1 (E1)
L-B - W-B
Cruise control main switch
circuit
Ignition switch ON, -/SET
switch hold ON
4.0 to 7.1 V
E7-2 (CCS) - E6-1 (E1)
L-B - W-B
Cruise control main switch
circuit
Ignition switch ON, +/RES
switch hold ON
2.1 to 4.0 V
E7-2 (CCS) - E6-1 (E1)
L-B - W-B
Cruise control main switch
circuit
Ignition switch ON, MAIN
switch hold ON
Below 1 V
E8-16 (ST1-) - E6-1 (E1)
R-L - W-B
Stop light signal
Ignition switch ON,
Depress brake pedal
Below 1 V
E8-16 (ST1-) - E6-1 (E1)
R-L - W-B
Stop light signal
Ignition switch ON,
Release brake pedal
10 to 14 V
E7-18 (PI) - E6-1 (E1)
LG - W-B
Cruise MAIN indicator light
signal
Ignition switch ON, Cruise
control main switch ON
0 to 3 V
E7-18 (PI) - E6-1 (E1)
LG - W-B
Cruise MAIN indicator light
signal
Ignition switch ON, Cruise
control main switch ON
9 to 14 V
CC
CC–12
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
The ECU controls the cruise control system of the
vehicle. The data and DTCs relating to the cruise control
system can be read from the DLC3 of the vehicle. If
CRUISE MAIN indicator light does not come on after the
DTC check, there is a malfunction on the cruise control
system.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECM uses the ISO 9141-2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2
format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminals No.)
CC
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
54 to 67 Ω
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
3 kΩ or higher
CANH (6) - BAT (16)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - BAT (16)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
3 kΩ or higher
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester to the
DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to
use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a
problem with either the vehicle or the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem may be in the tester itself. Consult the
Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
3.
CC–13
CHECK INDICATOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
I033556E01
CRUISE Main Indicator Light
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
ON
OFF
BE04034E01
(b) Check that the CRUISE main indicator light
illuminates when the cruise control main switch is
turned on, and that the indicator light turns off when
the main switch is turned off. If the results are not as
specified, inspect the CRUISE main indicator light
circuit (See page CC-23).
HINT:
While driving with cruise control, the ECM activates
AUTO CANCEL of the cruise control system when a
malfunction occurs in one of the following: vehicle
speed sensors, stop light switch, or other related
parts. When AUTO CANCEL is activated, the
CRUISE main indicator light outputs the blinking
pattern shown to the left. At the same time, data of
the malfunction is stored as a DTC.
CC
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–1
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
HANDLING PRECAUTION FOR CRUISE CONTROL
SYSTEM
(a) Turn the cruise control main switch off when not
using the cruise control system.
(b) Be careful as the vehicle speed increases when
driving downhill with the cruise control system on.
(c) The + (ACCEL)/RES (RESUME) operation changes
according to the cruise control system status. When
the cruise control system is operating, the +
(ACCEL) function operates. When the cruise control
system is not operating, the RES (RESUME)
function operates.
(d) If the CRUISE main indicator light blinks while the
cruise control system is operating, turn the cruise
control main switch off to reset the cruise control
system. After the reset, if the cruise control main
switch cannot be turned on, or the cruise control
system is canceled immediately after turning the
cruise control main switch on, the system may have
a malfunction.
(e) Do not use the cruise control system where the road
conditions are as follows:
• Heavy traffic
• Steep decline
• Roads with sharp turns
• Icy or snowy roads
• Slippery roads
CC
CC–2
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
STOP LIGHT
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
- CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR LIGHT
ECM
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
DLC3
IGNITION SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE J/B
- GAUGE FUSE
CC
- IGN FUSE
- STOP FUSE
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
E116111E03
CC–14
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
2.
CC
DTC CHECK
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the Controller
Area Network Vehicle Interface Module (CAN
VIM). Then connect the CAN VIM to the Data
Link Connector 3 (DLC3).
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
DTC CLEAR
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Operate the intelligent tester to erase the codes.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CC–15
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
HINT:
If the following conditions are detected while the cruise
control is in operation, the system clears the stored vehicle
speed in the ECM and cancels the cruise control operation.
Vehicle Condition
Auto Cancel Condition
•
CRUISE main indicator light blinks
Re-operation Condition
There is open or short in stop light switch
circuit
There is problem with vehicle speed
signal
There is problem with throttle position
sensor and motor
Turn cruise control main switch on again
There is problem with input circuit of stop
light switch circuit
There is problem with cancel circuit
•
•
•
Vehicle speed is lower than low speed
limit (approx. 40 km/h (25 mph)) while
running with cruise control on
Push cruise control main switch to +
(ACCEL)/RES (RESUME)
•
Vehicle speed is lower than stored speed
by approx. 16 km/h (9.9 mph) or more
Push cruise control main switch to - (COAST)/
SET
•
•
•
CRUISE main indicator light blinks
•
CRUISE main indicator light goes off
Turn cruise control main switch on again
Turn ignition switch off then on again
CC
CC–27
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
STEERING WHEEL
ASSEMBLY
50 (510, 37)
STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER NO. 2
STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER NO. 3
CC
STEERING PAD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C
C131315E06
CC–28
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CC
E116111E04
CC–16
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator, and other item values to be read
without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST
early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
ECM (Cruise control):
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed / min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed
-
MEMORY SPD
Cruise control memorized speed /
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), max.: 255
km/h (158 mph)
Actual stored vehicle speed
-
THROTTLE
Required throttle opening angle /
min. : 0°, max. : 125°
Actual required throttle opening
Diagnostic Note
-
Cruise control system active
condition / ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control activated
OFF: Cruise control deactivated
MAIN SW (MAIN)
Main switch signal (Main CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON: Main switch on (Pushed on)
OFF: Main switch off (Pushed off)
"3"
MAIN SW (SUB)
Main SW signal (Sub CPU) / ON
or OFF
ON: Main SW ON (Pressed in)
OFF: Main SW OFF (Pressed
out)
"3"
CCS READY M
Cruise control system standby
condition (Main CPU) / ON or
OFF
ON / OFF: Change ON/OFF each
time Main SW is pushed in.
"1"
CCS READY S
Cruise control system standby
condition (Sub CPU) / ON or OFF
ON / OFF: Change ON/OFF each
time Main SW is pushed in.
"1"
CCS INDICATOR M
Cruise indicator signal (Main
CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: "CCS READY" ON
OFF: "CCS READY" OFF
"2"
CCS INDICATOR S
Cruise indicator signal (Sub CPU)
/ ON or OFF
ON: "CCS READY" ON
OFF: "CCS READY" OFF
"2"
CANCEL switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: CANCEL switch on
OFF: CANCEL switch off
-
SET/COAST SW
-/SET switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: -/SET switch on
OFF: -/SET switch off
-
RES/ACC SW
+/RES switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: +/RES switch on
OFF: +/RES switch off
-
STP LIGHT SW2 M
Stop light switch signal (Main
CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
STP LIGHT SW2 S
Stop light switch signal (Sub
CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
STP LIGHT SW1 S
Stop light switch signal (Sub
CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
PNP switch signal (D position) /
ON or OFF
ON: Shift lever in D
OFF: Shift lever not in D
-
CRUISE CONTROL
CANCEL SW
CC
Normal Condition
SHIFT D POS
-
HINT:
• "3" is OK but "1" is NG → ECM failure
• "1" is OK but "2" is NG → DTC output or ECM
failure
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–17
• "3" is OK but CRUISE main indicator light does
not illuminate → CRUISE main indicator light,
wire harness, or ECM failure
CC
CC–18
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the trouble areas listed for that code in the table below and
proceed to the appropriate page.
DTC Code
CC
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Malfunction
-Combination meter assembly
-Vehicle speed sensor
-Vehicle speed sensor signal
circuit
-ECM
CC-15
P0503
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
Intermittent / Erratic / High
-Combination meter assembly
-Vehicle speed sensor
-Vehicle speed sensor circuit
-ECM
CC-15
P0571
Brake Switch "A" Circuit
-Stop light switch
-Stop light circuit
-ECM
CC-16
P0607
Control Module Performance
-ECM
CC-20
CC–19
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
DTC
P0503
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A" Intermittent / Erratic /
High
DESCRIPTION
for 2UZ-FE: Refer to DTC P0500 (See page ES-236).
for 1GR-FE: Refer to DTC P0500 (See page ES-263).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0500
The vehicle speed signal from the vehicle
speed sensor is cut for 0.14 sec. or more
while cruise control is in operation
•
•
•
•
Combination meter assembly
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor signal circuit
ECM
P0503
Momentary interruption and noise are
detected when a rapid change of vehicle
speed occurs while cruise control is in
operation
•
•
•
•
Combination meter assembly
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor signal circuit
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
for 2UZ-FE: Refer to DTC P0500 (See page ES-237).
for 1GR-FE: Refer to DTC P0500 (See page ES-264).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
for 2UZ-FE: Refer to DTC P0500 (See page ES-237).
for 1GR-FE: Refer to DTC P0500 (See page ES-264).
CC
CC–20
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0571
Brake Switch "A" Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light switch sends a signal to the ECM. When the ECM
receives this signal, it cancels the cruise control. The fail-safe function operates to enable normal driving
even if there is a malfunction in the stop light signal circuit. The cancellation condition occurs when
voltage is applied to terminal STP. When the brake is applied, voltage is normally applied to terminal STP
of the ECM through the STOP SW fuse and the stop light switch, and the ECM turns the cruise control off.
DTC No.
P0571
CC
DTC Detection Condition
Stop light switch assembly does not turn off
even once the vehicle is driven.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
ECM
CC–21
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Center J/B
15
IC3
G-Y
G-Y
E
E
3C
3C
11
J/C
H
G-Y
J31
E
J32
G-Y
E8
E8
S12
Stop Light SW
3
ST1-
Driver Side J/B
J4
J/C
B-O
4
STP
16
R-L
IC3
R-L
15
23
B-O
C
6
IGN
1E
C
1D
Engine Room R/B
J4
J/C
G-W
G-Y
B
ALT
STOP
B
2
2
1
2
2
1
2
1
B
2
AM2
B
2
2
1
2
R
R
Battery
CC
B-R
7
AM2
IG2
6
E116138E02
CC–22
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK STOP LIGHT SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Check that the stop light lights up when brake pedal is
depress and turns OFF when the brake pedal is
released.
NG
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH CIRCUIT
OK
2
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH
2
1
(a) Remove stop light switch (See page BR-7).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch pin not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Switch pin not pushed
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Switch pin pushed
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Switch pin pushed
10 kΩ or higher
3
4
Free Pushed in
E065594E56
(c) Install the stop light switch.
NG
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH
OK
3
CHECK ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
E8
CC
ECM Connector
ST1- STP
A131509E68
Reconnect the stop light switch connector.
Remove the ECM with connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
E8-15 (STP) - Body
ground
Depressed
10 to 14 V
E8-15 (STP) - Body
ground
Released
Below 1 V
E8-16 (ST1-) - Body
ground
Depressed
Below 1 V
E8-16 (ST1-) - Body
ground
Released
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STOP LIGHT SWITCH - ECM)
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–23
OK
REPLACE ECM
CC
CC–24
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0607
Control Module Performance
DESCRIPTION
This DTC indicates the internal abnormalities of the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
P0607
Cruise control input signal abnormal.
Stop light switch input signal abnormal.
Trouble Area
•
ECM
HINT:
The ECM receives signals from each sensor to control all functions of the cruise control system. When a
trouble code is detected, the fail-safe function remains on until the engine switch is turned off.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
NEXT
END
CC
REPLACE ECM
CC–25
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Cruise Control Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit carries the -/SET, +/RES and CANCEL signals (each voltage) to the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C13
Cruise Control Main Switch
ON-OFF
4
L-B
CCS 5
ECC
CANCEL
BR
-SET
10
IM2
3
IK1
L-B
2
E7
CCS
+RES
BR
J28 J/C (*2)
E(*2)
BR
E(*2)
BR
*1: 2UZ-FE
*2: 1GR-FE
ED (*1)
EE (*2)
I045663E02
CC
CC–26
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Remove the cruise control main switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
+/RES
ON
CANCEL
OFF
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
4-5
Neutral
10 kΩ or higher
4-5
+/RES
210 to 270 Ω
4-5
-/SET
560 to 700 Ω
4-5
CANCEL
1,380 to 1,700 Ω
4-5
Main Switch off
10 kΩ or higher
4-5
Main Switch on
Below 1 Ω
-/SET
4 5
NG
REPLACE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
I033811E01
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH, BODY
GROUND - ECM)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between cruise control main switch and ECM
(See page IN-38).
(b) Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between cruise control main switch and body
ground (See page IN-38).
NG
CC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
CC–27
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Cruise Main Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned off, the cruise control does not operate.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Driver Side J/B
GAUGE
6
1D
Combination Meter
4
1G
R-L
15
11
C10
C8
LG
18
E7 PI
CRUISE
Engine Room R/B
I18
Ignition S/W
B-R
R
6
IG2
AM2 7
AM2
2
2
2
B
1
Battery
I045664E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) See combination meter troubleshooting (See page ME4).
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
2
CC
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY - ECM)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between combination meter assembly and
ECM (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
CC–28
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
CC
CC–29
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 causes the system to enter self-diagnostic mode. If a
malfunction is present, DTCs will be output.
HINT:
When a particular warning light remains blinking, a ground short in the wiring of terminal TC of the DLC3
or an internal ground short in the relevant ECU is suspected.
WIRING DIAGRAM
D1
DLC3
TC
CG
J18
J/C
P-L
13
H
W-B
4
E
Center J/B
P-L
H
J22
J/C
C
3C
ECM
C
3C
P-L
E J/C A
J29
J30
P-L
23
E8
TC
W-B
E
A
J5
J/C
IG
I033551E01
CC
CC–30
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DLC3 (TC TERMINAL VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(b) Measure the voltage of the DLC3.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OK
9 10111213141516
DLC3
Go to step 3
TC
F040034E31
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between terminal CG of DLC3 and body
ground (See page IN-38).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between terminal TC of DLC3 and ECM (See
page IN-38).
NG
OK
CC
CHECK AND REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR OR EACH ECU
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CC–29
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
HINT:
See page RS-1.
2.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
3.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
5.
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
E062033
(b) Remove the 2 screws and cruise control main
switch.
E062034
CC
CC–30
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
INSTALLATION
CC
1.
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
2.
INSTALL STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
3.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
4.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
5.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
6.
INSPECT STEERING PAD (See page RS-389)
7.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
HINT:
See page RS-28.
LI–6
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the lighting system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
NEXT
3
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
4
INSPECT MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to step 8
A
LI
5
CHECK FOR DTC*
Result
Result
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
Proceed to
DTC is not output
Go to step 8
LI–7
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
If fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
If fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 8
A
7
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) Data List / Active Test (See page LI-14)
(b) Terminals of ECU (See page LI-11)
(c) Inspection
NEXT
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
9
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
LI
LI–8
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
2.
LI
3.
ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM OPERATION CHECK
(a) The light that is lit in the illuminated entry system is
explained below:
(b) Turn the ignition switch to OFF, close all the doors,
and set the driver's door in the lock condition.
(c) Unlock the door and open any other door, and
check that the room light comes on. Close the door,
and check that the room light goes off within 15
seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and open and close
any other door. Check that the room light
immediately goes off.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
(f) Open and close any door to light the room light.
Before the room light goes off within 15 seconds,
turn the ignition switch to ON, and check that the
room light goes off immediately.
(g) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(h) Open and close any door to light the room light.
Before the light goes off within 15 seconds, lock the
driver door. Check that the light goes off
immediately.
DOME RELAY CUT OPERATION CHECK
(a) Remove the ignition key and close all doors.
(b) Open the driver door to light the room light, and
leave it as opened. Check that the light goes off in
about 30 min.
(c) After the room light goes off, close the driver's door.
(d) Open any door except the driver's door to turn the
room light on, and then open the driver's door.
Check that room light goes off within 30 min. after
opening the driver's door.
(e) Close all the doors. With the ignition key inserted,
open any door to light the room light, and then,
remove the ignition key. Check that the room light
goes off within 30 min.
(f) One of the room light switches is on and close all
doors.
(g) Lock all doors, and check that the room light goes
off within 3 sec.
SIDE STEP LIGHT OPERATION CHECK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to OFF, close all the doors,
and set the driver door in the lock condition.
(b) Unlock the door and open front or rear doors, and
check that the side step light comes on. Close the
door and check that the side step light goes off
within 15 seconds.
(c) Under the conditions that the ignition switch is ON,
one of the front or rear doors opens and the shift
range is at any positions except for P positions,
check that the side step light goes off when the
vehicle speed exceeds 8 km/h (4.8 mph).
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
4.
LI–9
(d) Then, check that the side step light comes on when
the vehicle speed become 4 km/h (2.4 mph) or less.
LIGHT AUTO CUT OPERATION CHECK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and turn the
headlight switch to TAIL or HEAD.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to OFF, and open and close
the driver's door, check the headlight goes off within
30 sec.
LI
LI–10
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
1. HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT
Symptom
Only one headlight comes on.
Headlight does not light up.
"HI-Beam" does not light (All).
"HI-Beam" does not light (One side).
"Flash" does not light.
Headlight is dark.
Only one taillight up.
Taillight does not light up. (Headlight is normal)
Taillight does not light up. (Headlight does not light)
Rear combination light does not light up.
Headlight does not light up with engine running and
light control switch is in OFF (Day time running light
operation).
Suspected area
See page
1. Bulb
-
2. HEAD LH fuse (LWR, UPR)
-
3. HEAD RH fuse (LWR, UPR)
-
4. Harness or connector
-
Headlight relay circuit
LI-20
1. Headlight dimmer switch
LI-68
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
LI-68
2. Turn signal flasher relay
LI-72
3. Harness or connector
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Harness or connector
-
Taillight relay circuit
LI-31
1. Light Control Switch
LI-68
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Turn signal flasher and DRL relay
LI-72
2. Generator L terminal
-
3. Parking brake switch
-
4. Multiplex network body ECU
-
5. Harness or connector
-
2. AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Automatic light control system does not operate
Suspected area
Automatic light control sensor circuit
See page
LI-22
3. LIGHT AUTO CUT SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Door courtesy switch
Light auto turn off system does not operate.
LI
Headlight and taillight do not come on.
Headlight and taillight stay on.
See page
-
2. Automatic light control sensor circuit
LI-22
3. Multiplex network body ECU
-
4. Harness or connector
-
1. Multiplex network body ECU
-
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Multiplex network body ECU
-
2. Harness or connector
-
4. FOG LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Front fog light does not light up with light control SW
HEAD (Headlight is normal).
Suspected area
See page
1. FOG Fuse
-
2. FOG relay
LI-76
3. Fog light switch
LI-68
4. Harness or connector
-
LI–11
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symptom
Only one front fog light does not light up.
Suspected area
See page
1. Bulb
-
2. Harness or connector
-
5. TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. IG1 Fuse
"Hazard" and "Turn" do not light up.
Hazard warning light does not light up. (Turn is normal)
Turn signal does not light up. (Hazard is normal)
Turn signal does not light up in one direction.
Only one bulb does not light up.
See page
-
2. Ignition switch
-
3. Turn signal flasher
LI-72
4. Harness or connector
-
1. Hazard warning switch
LI-70
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Turn signal switch
LI-68
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Turn signal switch
LI-68
2. Harness or connector
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Harness or connector
-
6. ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM
Symptom
Room light assembly No. 1 does not light up.
Room light assembly No. 1 does not go off.
Courtesy light does not light up.
Courtesy light does not go off.
Side step light does not light up.
Side step light does not go off.
Suspected area
1. Illumination circuit
See page
LI-25
2. Multiplex network body ECU
-
1. Illumination circuit
LI-25
2. Multiplex network body ECU
-
1. Courtesy light
LI-63
2. Courtesy light switch
-
3. Harness or connector
-
4. Driver side junction block assembly
-
1. Courtesy light switch
-
2. Harness or connector
-
3. Courtesy light
LI-63
4. Driver side junction block assembly
-
1. Side step light
LI-65
2. Courtesy light switch
-
3. Harness or connector
-
4. Multiplex network body ECU
-
1. Courtesy light switch
-
2. Harness or connector
-
3. Side step light
LI-65
4. Multiplex network body ECU
-
LI
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–39
ADJUSTMENT
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
E116124E01
1.
PREPARE VEHICLE FOR HEADLIGHT AIMING
ADJUSTMENT
(a) Prepare the vehicle according to the following
conditions:
• Ensure that there is no damage or deformation to
the body around the headlights.
• Fill the fuel tank.
• Make sure that the oil is filled to the specified
level.
• Make sure that the coolant is filled to the
specified level.
• Inflate the tires to the appropriate pressure.
• Place the spare tire, tools, and jack in their
original positions.
• Unload the trunk.
• Sit a person of average weight (68 kg, 150 lb) in
the driver's seat.
2.
PREPARE FOR HEADLIGHT AIMING (Using a
screen)
(a) Prepare the vehicle according to the following
conditions:
• Place the vehicle in a location that is dark
enough to clearly observe the cutoff line. The
cutoff line is a distinct line, below which light from
the headlights can be observed and above which
it cannot.
• Place the vehicle at a 90° angle to the wall.
• Position the vehicle (headlight bulb center) 7.62
m (25 ft) away from the wall.
• Place the vehicle on a level surface.
• Bounce the vehicle up and down to settle the
suspension.
NOTICE:
A distance of 7.62 m (25 ft) between the vehicle
(headlight bulb center) and the wall is necessary
for proper aim adjustment. If it is not possible to
achieve this distance, secure a distance of
exactly 3 m (9.84 ft) for checking and
adjustment. (The target zone will change with
the distance so follow the instructions in the
illustration.)
(b) Prepare a piece of thick white paper (approximately
2 m (6.6 ft) (height) x 4 m (13.1 ft) (width)) to use as
a screen.
(c) Draw a vertical line down the center of screen (V
line).
LI
LI–40
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
(d) Set the screen as shown in the illustration.
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
V RH Line
V RH Line
V Line
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
V Line
V LH Line
V LH Line
H Line
H Line
3 m (9.84 ft)
7.62 m (25 ft)
E116125E01
HINT:
• Stand the screen perpendicular to the ground.
• Align the V line on the screen with the center of
the vehicle.
V LH Line
V Line
V RH Line
H Line
Ground
I033423E18
LI
(e) Draw base lines (H line, V LH and V RH lines) on
the screen as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
• The base lines differ for "low-beam inspection"
and "high-beam inspection".
• Mark the headlight bulb center marks on the
screen. If the center mark cannot be observed on
the headlight, use the center of the headlight
bulb or the manufacturer's name marked on the
headlight as the center mark.
(1) H Line (Headlight height):
Draw a horizontal line across the screen so that
it passes through the center marks. The H line
should be at the same height as the headlight
bulb center marks of the low-beam headlights.
(2) V LH Line, V RH Line (Center mark position of
left-hand (LH) and right-hand (RH) headlights):
Draw two vertical lines so that they intersect the
H line at each center mark (aligned with the
center of the low-beam headlight bulbs).
LI–41
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
3.
INSPECT HEADLIGHT AIMING
(a) Cover the headlight or disconnect the connector of
the headlight on the opposite side to prevent light
from the headlight that is not being inspected from
affecting headlight aiming inspection.
NOTICE:
Do not keep the headlight covered for more than
3 minutes. The headlight lens is made of
synthetic resin, and may easily melt or be
damaged due to heat.
HINT:
When checking the aim of the high-beam, cover the
low-beam or disconnect the connector.
(b) Start the engine.
NOTICE:
Engine rpm must be 1,500 or more.
(c) Turn on the headlight and make sure that the cutoff
line falls within the specified area as shown in the
illustration.
Alingning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
V LH Line V RH Line
Low Beam:
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
H Line
53 mm
(2.08 in.)
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
H Line
101 mm 101 mm
(3.97 in.) (3.97 in.)
V LH Line V RH Line
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
21 mm
(0.82 in.)
Cutoff Line
High Beam:
40 mm
40 mm
(1.57 in.) (1.57 in.)
V LH Line V RH Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
H Line
H Line
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
V LH Line V RH Line
Low Beam:
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
Cutoff Line
High Beam:
Alingning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
101 mm 101 mm
(3.97 in.) (3.97 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
LI
40 mm
40 mm
(1.57 in.) (1.57 in.)
I041213E07
LI–42
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
Aiming Screw
E116126E01
LI
4.
ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIMING
(a) Adjust the aim vertically:
Adjust the headlight aim into the specified range by
turning the aiming screw with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
The final turn of the aiming screw should be
made in the clockwise direction. If the screw is
tightened excessively, loosen it and then
retighten it, so that the final turn of the screw is
in the clockwise direction.
HINT:
• Perform low-beam aim adjustment.
• The headlight aim moves down when turning the
aiming screw clockwise, and moves up when
turning the aiming screw counterclockwise.
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–43
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL CLEARANCE LIGHT BULB
(a) Install the clearance light bulb.
2.
INSTALL FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
(a) Install the front turn signal light bulb.
3.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT NO. 2 BULB
(a) Install the headlight No. 2 bulb.
4.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT NO. 1 BULB
(a) Install the headlight No. 1 bulb.
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the headlight assembly with the 3 screws and
the bolt.
(b) Connect the connectors.
2.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER FILLER
(a) Install the front bumper filler with the clip.
3.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
6.
PREPARE VEHICLE FOR HEADLIGHT AIMING
ADJUSTMENT
7.
PREPARE FOR HEADLIGHT AIMING (Using a tester)
8.
PREPARE FOR HEADLIGHT AIMING (Using a
screen)
9.
INSPECT HEADLIGHT AIMING
E116119
E116118
10. ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIMING
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
LI
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–1
LIGHTING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION OF HEADLIGHT BULB
REPLACEMENT
(a) If the adhered oil is left unremoved from the halogen
light surface, the light service life is shortened as it
becomes hot when it is turned on.
(b) Since the internal pressure of a halogen light is
high, dropping, hitting or damaging the bulb may
cause the glass to scatter. Therefore, handle it with
great care.
(c) When replacing bulbs, do not remove until a new
bulb is prepared. Because if it is left being removed
for a long period of time, the lens may be covered
with dirt or moisture.
(d) Be sure to use the bulb of the same watt when
replacing bulbs.
(e) Firmly reinstall the socket after replacing the bulb.
Otherwise, cloudy lens or invasion by water will be
caused.
LI
LI–2
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- DOME RELAY
- ACC CUT RELAY
- HEADLIGHT RELAY
- FOG RELAY
- STOP LP CTRL RELAY
- AMI FUSE
- DOME FUSE
- ECUB
- HEADLIGHT LH FUSE
- HEADLIGHT RH FUSE
- J/B FUSE
- STOP FUSE
ENGINE ROOM R/B NO. 3
- TOWING, TAIL RELAY
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
FOG LIGHT
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT
LI
C131563E01
LI–3
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER RELAY
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER AND
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
(KEY CYLINDER LIGHT ASSEMBLY)
- TAIL RELAY
MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY COMPUTER
LI
E115632E01
LI–4
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
WITH RSA:
ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
VANITY LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR
COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
PERSONAL LIGHT ASSEMBLY
VANITY LIGHT ASSEMBLY
ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
STEP LIGHT
ASSEMBLY
LI
DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
C131564E01
LI–5
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
WITH REAR SPOILER:
STOP CENTER LIGHT ASSEMBLY
TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
REAR ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
STOP CENTER
LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI
MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR COMPUTER
BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH)
E115633E01
LI–46
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT PROTECTOR RETAINER
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT PROTECTOR RETAINER
UPPER LH
HINT:
When only the installation part of the headlight unit
assembly LH is damaged, it can be repaired
inexpensively by using a headlight protector retainer
upper LH. In this case, however, the headlight unit
assembly LH itself should not be damaged.
(a) Cut off the part shaded in the illustration and sand
smooth with sandpaper.
NOTICE:
After cutting off the part, place the headlight
protector retainer upper LH against the bosses
and gradually file away the old bracket if it
interferes with the installation of the supply
bracket.
I034335
(b) Install the headlight protector retainer upper LH with
the 2 screws.
I034336
LI
2.
INSPECT HEADLIGHT AIMING (See page LI-41)
3.
ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIMING (See page LI-42)
LI–48
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
ADJUSTMENT
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
E116130E01
LI
1.
PREPARE VEHICLE FOR FOG LIGHT AIMING
ADJUSTMENT
(a) Prepare the vehicle according to the following
conditions:
• Ensure that there is no damage or deformation to
the body around the fog lights.
• Fill the fuel tank.
• Make sure that the oil is filled to the specified
level.
• Make sure that the coolant is filled to the
specified level.
• Inflate the tires to the appropriate pressure.
• Place the spare tire, tools, and jack in their
original positions.
• Unload the trunk.
• Sit a person of average weight (68 kg, 150 lb) in
the driver's seat.
2.
PREPARE FOR FOG LIGHT AIMING
(a) Prepare the vehicle according to the following
conditions:
• Place the vehicle in a location that is dark
enough to clearly observe the cutoff line. The
cutoff line is a distinct line, below which light from
the fog lights can be observed and above which it
cannot.
• Place the vehicle at a 90° angle to the wall.
• Position the vehicle (fog light bulb center) 7.62 m
(25 ft) away from the wall.
• Place the vehicle on a level surface.
• Bounce the vehicle up and down to settle the
suspension.
NOTICE:
A distance of 7.62 m (25 ft) between the vehicle
(fog light bulb center) and the wall is necessary
for proper aim adjustment. If it is not possible to
achieve this distance, secure a distance of
exactly 3 m (9.84 ft) for checking and
adjustment. (The target zone will change with
the distance, so follow the instructions in the
illustration.)
(b) Prepare a piece of thick white paper (approximately
2 m (6.6 ft) (height) x 4 m (13.1 ft) (width)) to use as
a screen.
(c) Draw a vertical line down the center of screen (V
line).
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–49
(d) Set the screen as shown in the illustration.
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
V RH Line
V RH Line
V Line
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
V Line
V LH Line
V LH Line
H Line
H Line
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
E116131E01
HINT:
• Stand the screen perpendicular to the ground.
• Align the V line on the screen with the center of
the vehicle.
V LH Line
V Line
(e) Draw base lines (H line, V LH and V RH lines) on
the screen as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Mark the fog light bulb center marks on the screen.
If the center mark cannot be observed on the fog
light, use the center of the fog light bulb or the
manufacturer's name marked on the fog light as the
center mark.
(1) H Line (Fog light height):
Draw a horizontal line across the screen so that
it passes through the center marks. The H line
should be at the same height as the fog light
bulb center marks of the low-beam fog lights.
(2) V LH Line, V RH Line (Center mark position of
left-hand (LH) and right-hand (RH) fog lights):
Draw two vertical lines so that they intersect the
H line at each center mark.
V RH Line
H Line
Ground
I033423E18
3.
INSPECT FOG LIGHT AIMING
(a) Cover the fog light or disconnect the connector of
the fog light on the opposite side to prevent light
from the fog light that is not being inspected from
affecting fog light aiming inspection.
(b) Start the engine.
NOTICE:
Engine rpm must be 1,500 or more.
LI
LI–50
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(c) Turn on the fog light and make sure that the cutoff
line falls within the specified area as shown in the
illustration.
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
V LH Line
V RH Line
V LH Line
133 mm
(5.24 in.)
H Line
V RH Line
52 mm
(2.05 in.)
H Line
I041221E15
4.
Aiming Screw
E116132E01
LI
ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIMING
(a) Adjust the fog light aim into the specified range by
turning the aiming screw with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
The final turn of the aiming screw should be
made in the clockwise direction. If the screw is
tightened excessively, loosen it and then
retighten it, so that the final turn of the screw is
in the clockwise direction.
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–51
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FOG LIGHT BULB
(a) Install the fog light bulb.
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Engage the 3 claws and install the fog light
assembly.
2.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER
(a) Engage the 4 claws and install the front bumper
hole cover.
3.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PREPARE VEHICLE FOR FOG LIGHT AIMING
ADJUSTMENT
6.
PREPARE FOR FOG LIGHT AIMING
7.
INSPECT FOG LIGHT AIMING
8.
ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIMING
9.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
E116128
E116242
LI
LI–56
LIGHTING – LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD (See page ED53)
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE
3.
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the 4 screws and remove the licence plate
light assembly.
4.
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LENS
(a) Remove the 4 screws and 2 license plate light
lenses.
5.
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LENS GASKET
6.
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT BULB
(a) Remove the 2 license plate light bulbs as shown in
the illustration.
7.
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT BODY
I033435
I033436
I033437
LI
LIGHTING – LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–57
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT BODY
2.
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT BULB
3.
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LENS GASKET
4.
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LENS
5.
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL BACK DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE
7.
INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD
LI
LI–60
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT BULB (without Rear
Spoiler)
2.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (with
Rear Spoiler)
3.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (with
Rear Spoiler)
4.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (without
Rear Spoiler)
LI–12
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
Multiplex Network Body Computer
Front side:
1A
1F
B6
B5
B4
1E
1C
1D
1B
Back side:
1G
1J
1L
LI
1K
1H
I034371E02
LI–13
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring color
1H-2 ←→ Body ground
(GND1 ←→ Body ground)
-
1K-15, 1L-16 ←→ 1H-2
(LSR ←→ GND1, 2)
-
1C-2 ←→ 1H-2
(SIG ←→ GND1, 2)
-
1B-4 ←→ 1H-2
(BECU ←→ GND1, 2)
-
1A-8, 1K-9 ←→ 1H-2
(ILE ←→ GND1, 2)
-
1H-2 ←→ Body ground
(GND2 ←→ Body ground)
-
1B-8 ←→ 1H-2
(HRLY ←→ GND1, 2)
-
1C-1 ←→ 1H-2
(TRLY ←→ GND1, 2)
-
1D-5 ←→ 1H-2
(ACC ←→ GND1, 2)
-
B4-3 ←→ 1H-2
(LMRY ←→ GND1, 2)
R ←→ -
B4-7 ←→ 1H-2
(DRL ←→ GND1, 2)
LG-R ←→ -
B4-21 ←→ 1H-2
(LSWD ←→ GND1, 2)
W-R ←→ -
B4-23 ←→ 1H-2
(MPX2 ←→ GND1, 2)
BR-R ←→ -
B4-25 ←→ 1H-2
(PCYL ←→ GND1, 2)
Y ←→ -
B4-26 ←→ 1H-2
(DCYL ←→ GND1, 2)
W-G ←→ -
B4-30 ←→ 1H-2
(LSWP ←→ GND1, 2)
B-W ←→ -
B5-6 ←→ 1H-2
(LP ←→ GND1, 2)
W-R ←→ -
B5-11 ←→ 1H-2
(RLCY ←→ GND1, 2)
P-B ←→ -
B5-12 ←→ 1H-2
(RRCY ←→ GND1, 2)
P-L ←→ -
B5-21 ←→ 1H-2
(LCYL ←→ GND1, 2)
P-G ←→ -
B5-22 ←→ 1H-2
(RCYL ←→ GND1, 2)
L-R ←→ -
B5-23 ←→ 1H-2
(DCTY ←→ GND1, 2)
R-B ←→ -
B5-24 ←→ 1H-2
(PCTY ←→ GND1, 2)
R-Y ←→ -
B6-1 ←→ 1H-2
(HEAD ←→ GND1, 2)
R ←→ -
B6-3 ←→ 1H-2
(A ←→ GND1, 2)
G-O ←→ -
Condition
Constant
Specified condition
Below 1 V
Rear door lock switch is unlock position
Below 1 V
Rear door lock switch is lock position
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON
10 to 14 V
Constant
10 to 14 V
Key cylinder illumination, room light is OFF
Below 1 V
Key cylinder illumination, room light is ON
10 to 14 V
Constant
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is HEAD
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is TAIL
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON
10 to 14 V
Front LH door lock switch is unlock position
Below 1 V
Front LH door lock switch is lock position
10 to 14 V
Constant
Signal waveform
Front RH courtesy light is OFF
10 to 14 V
Front RH courtesy light is ON
Below 1 V
Front LH courtesy light is OFF
10 to 14 V
Front LH courtesy light is ON
Below 1 V
Front RH door lock switch is unlock position
Below 1 V
Front RH door lock switch is lock position
10 to 14 V
Side step light is OFF
Below 1 V
Side step light is ON
10 to 14 V
Rear LH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Rear LH door is open
Below 1 V
Rear RH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Rear RH door is open
Below 1 V
Rear LH courtesy light is OFF
10 to 14 V
Rear LH courtesy light is ON
Below 1 V
Rear RH courtesy light is OFF
10 to 14 V
Rear RH courtesy light is ON
Below 1 V
Front LH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Front LH door is open
Below 1 V
Front RH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Front RH door is open
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is ON
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is AUTO
Below 1 V
LI
LI–14
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring color
B6-4 ←→ 1H-2
(CLTS ←→ GND1, 2)
Y ←→ -
B6-6 ←→ 1H-2
(CLTB ←→ GND1, 2)
L-Y ←→ -
B6-8 ←→ 1H-2
(TAIL ←→ GND1, 2)
G ←→ -
B6-21 ←→ 1H-2
(CLTE ←→ GND1, 2)
G-W ←→ -
Condition
Specified condition
Cover the sensor with hand → Stop covering
Signal waveform
Ignition switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is ON
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch is ON and combination switch is TAIL
Below 1 V
Constant
Below 1 V
2.
Multiplex Network Door ECU:
B9
B8
I033329E03
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring color
B8-1 ←→ B8-3
(MPX2 ←→ GND)
R ←→ W-B
Constant
Signal waveform
B8-3 ←→ Body ground
(GND ←→ Body ground)
W-B ←→ -
Constant
Below 1 V
B8-4 ←→ B8-3
(BDR ←→ GND)
L ←→ W-B
Constant
10 to 14 V
B8-5 ←→ B8-3
(BECU ←→ GND)
L-R ←→ W-B
Constant
10 to 14 V
B8-6 ←→ B8-3
(SIG ←→ GND)
B ←→ W-B
Ignition switch is OFF
Below 1 V
B9-7 ←→ B8-3
(FULL ←→ GND)
LI
G-Y ←→ W-B
B9-8 ←→ B8-3
(POS ←→ GND)
BR-W ←→ W-B
B9-21 ←→ B8-3
(LSE ←→ GND)
B-R ←→ W-B
Condition
Specified condition
Ignition switch is ON
10 to 14 V
Backdoor is closed
10 to 14 V
Backdoor is open
Below 1 V
Backdoor lock switch is unlock position
Below 1 V
Backdoor lock switch is lock position
10 to 14 V
Constant
10 to 14 V
LI–35
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
FRONT BUMPER FILLER
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
LI
FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
E115634E01
LI–36
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
HEADLIGHT NO. 1 BULB
HEADLIGHT NO. 2 BULB
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
FRONT TURN
SIGNAL LIGHT
SOCKET
CLEARANCE
LIGHT SOCKET
CLEARANCE LIGHT BULB
SUPPLY PARTS:
HEADLIGHT PROTECTOR
RETAINER UPPER
LI
E115635E01
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–15
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
2.
USING INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Hook up the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Monitor the ECU data by following the prompts on
the tester screen.
HINT:
Intelligent tester has a "Snapshot" function which
records the monitored data.
Please refer to the intelligent tester operator's
manual for further details.
DTC CLEAR
(a) DTCs and freeze frame data will be erased by the
intelligent tester operating.
LI
LI–16
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the intelligent
tester, you can read the value of the switch, sensor,
actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the
DATA LIST as a first step of troubleshooting is one of the
methods to shorten labor time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, read the "DATA
LIST".
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
D DOR CTY SW
Driver's door courtesy SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Driver's door is open
OFF: Driver's door is close
-
P DOR CYT SW
Passenger's door courtesy
SW signal/ON or OFF
ON: Passenger's door is open
OFF: Passenger's door is close
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Either right or left rear door is open
OFF: Both the right and left doors are closed.
-
HIGH FLASHER SW
High flasher SW signal/
ON or OFF
ON: High flasher SW is on
OFF: High flasher SW is off
-
AUTO LIGHT SW
Auto light SW signal/ON or
OFF
ON: Light control SW is in Auto position
OFF: Light control SW is in except Auto position
-
HEAD LIGHT SW
Head light SW signal/ON
or OFF
ON: Light control SW is in HEAD position
OFF: Light control SW is in except HEAD position
-
TAIL LIGHT SW
Taillight SW signal/ON or
OFF
ON: Light control SW is in TAIL or HEAD position
OFF: Light control SW is in OFF or AUTO position
-
ACC SW
ACC SW signal/ON or
OFF
ON: IG key is in ACC, ON or START position
OFF: IG key is in OFF position
-
IG SW
IG SW signal/ON or OFF
ON: IG key is in ON or START position
OFF: IG key is in OFF or ACC position
-
Normal Condition
2.
LI
Item
Diagnostic Note
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate
without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
a first step of troubleshooting is one of the methods to
shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, perform the
"ACTIVE TEST".
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
HAZARD
Turns Hazard light flasher relay ON/OFF
-
DRL RLY
(Test Details)
Turns DRL relay ON/OFF
(Vehicle Condition)
IG SW is ON, Engine is stopped and Light
control SW is in OFF position.
-
HEAD LIGHT
TAIL LIGHT
Turns Head light relay ON/OFF
-
Turns Taillight relay ON/OFF
-
LI–17
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
ILLUMI OUTPUT
(Test Details)
Turns Interior light and Key illumination ON/
OFF
(Vehicle Condition)
Interior light SW is in Door position
-
DOME RLY CUT
Dome relay cut ON/OFF
-
LI
LI–44
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT PROTECTOR RETAINER
HEADLIGHT PROTECTOR RETAINER
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
FRONT BUMPER FILLER
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
LI
FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
E115634E01
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT PROTECTOR RETAINER
LI–45
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER (See
page LI-37)
4.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER FILLER (See page LI-37)
5.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page LI-37)
LI
LI–18
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
DTC CHECK
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the suspected area listed for that code in the table
below, and proceed to the appropriate page.
LIGHTING SYSTEM
DTC No.
B1244
LI
Detection Item
Light Sensor Circuit Malfunction
Suspected Area
1. Light sensor
2. Wire harness
3. Driver side junction block
assembly
See page
LI-16
LI–19
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DTC
B1244
Light Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when failure in the light sensor circuit is detected.
DTC No.
B1244
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
Malfunction of light sensor
Open or short of light sensor circuit
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Automatic light control sensor
Harness or connector
Driver side junction block assembly
LI
LI–20
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
A39
Automatic Light Control Sensor
CLTB
L-Y
3
IG1
L-Y
G-W
2
IG1
G-W
Y
1
IG1
Y
1
CLTE
3
CLTS
4
21
B6 CLTE
4
B6 CLTS
Driver Side J/B Assembly
I18 Ignition SW
2 AM1
6
B6 CLTB
IG1 4
L-Y
3
W-G
ACC
2
1C
ECU-IG
5
1D
ACC
10
22
SIG
ACC
Engine Room R/B
AM1
W-L
2
B
2
ALT
1 2
1
2
2
B
2
W-B
Light Control SW
W-B
G-O
10
IH1
G-O
3
B6 A
16
12
EL A C12
Combination SW
OFF
AUTO
A J/C A
J15
J15
W-B
A
LI
J5
J/C
Battery
IG
E072982E01
LI–21
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlight and the taillight come on.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and push the intelligent
tester main SW ON.
(c) Select the item "AUTO LIGHT SW" in the DATA LIST,
and read its value displayed on the intelligent tester.
OK:
Light control SW AUTO → ON
Light control SW except AUTO → OFF
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Measure voltage between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
(b) Check the continuity between terminal 3 (CLTE) and
body ground as shown in the chart below.
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check that signal waveform
appears between terminals.
E065750
Standard voltage
Terminal No. (Symbol)
Tester connection
Condition
1 (CLTB)
1-3
Constant
10 to 14 V
3 (CLTE)
3 - Body ground
Constant
Continuity
4 (CLTS)
4-3
IG SW ON
Dimmer SW AUTO
Signal waveform appears
depending on outside
brightness
NG
OK
Specified condition
REPLACE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL
SENSOR
LI
LI–22
4
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN BODY ECU AND AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL SENSOR)
(a) Check that signal waveform appears between terminals
B6-4 (CLTS) and B6-21 (CLTE) of the multiplex network
body ECU.
Standard:
Bar appears
(b) Measure voltage between terminals B6-6 (CLTB) and
B6-21 (CLTE) of the multiplex network body ECU.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
(c) Check the continuity between terminal B6-21 (CLTE) of
the multiplex network body ECU and body ground.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY AND BODY ECU)
(a) Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
LI
LI–46
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
FOG LIGHT BULB
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
LI
FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
E115636E01
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–47
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
3.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER
(a) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the front
bumper hole cover.
4.
REMOVE FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 3 claws and remove the fog light
assembly.
E116242
E116128
DISASSEMBLY
1.
E116129
REMOVE FOG LIGHT BULB
(a) Turn the fog light bulb counterclockwise and remove
it.
LI
LI–23
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Headlight Relay Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Engine Room R/B
ECU-B
2
1
W
2
B
2
1
2
2
5
3
2
1
2
W
17
BECU
HRLY
Driver
Side J/B
Assembly
2
R-B
2
2
2
1
HEAD (LO RH)
H4
Headlight RH (Low)
W-B
Short Pin 1
11
HEAD (LO LH)
R-Y
1
HEAD Relay
4
1B
8
1B
W-R
2
H2
Headlight LH (Low)
W-B
2
2
R-B
2
2
W-B
1
R
W-B
B
1
IH1
W-B
1
B6 HEAD
R
13
16
H T EL
Light
Control SW
OFF
Head
C12
Combination SW
A J15
J/C
A J15
W-B
A
J5
J/C
Battery
EA
EB
IG
E064840E01
LI
LI–24
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT HEADLIGHT RELAY
(a) Check the continuity of the headlight relay.
Standard
Condition
E064835
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1-2
Continuity
Constant
3-5
No continuity
Apply B+ between
terminal 1 and 2
3-5
Continuity
NG
REPLACE HEADLIGHT RELAY
OK
2
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY (HEAD)
(a) Inspect light control switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is a continuity between terminals at
each switch position as shown in the chart.
Standard
I033101
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
HEAD
13 - 16 - 14
Continuity
NG
REPLACE HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN BODY ECU AND HEADLIGHT DIMMER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check the continuity terminal B6-1 (HEAD) of the
multiplex network body ECU and the headlight dimmer
switch assembly.
Standard:
There is continuity
LI
NG
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
LI–52
LIGHTING – REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT BULB
REAR COMBINATION LIGHT SOCKET
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT BULB
LI
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT ASSEMBLY
E115637E01
LIGHTING – REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–53
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT SERVICE
COVER
3.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts.
(c) Disconnect the pin and remove the rear
combination light assembly.
Pin
E116133E01
Rear Combination
Light Socket
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT BULB
(a) Remove the 2 rear combination light sockets.
(b) Remove the 2 rear combination light bulbs from the
2 rear combination light sockets.
E116134E01
Rear Combination
Light Socket
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REAR COMBINATION LIGHT BULB
(a) Install the 2 rear combination light bulbs to the 2
rear combination light sockets.
(b) Install the 2 rear combination light sockets.
E116134E01
INSTALLATION
1.
2.
INSTALL REAR COMBINATION LIGHT SERVICE
COVER
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
Pin
E116133E01
INSTALL REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Connect the pin and install the rear combination
light assembly.
(c) Install the 2 nuts.
LI
LI–25
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Automatic Light Control Sensor Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
A39
Automatic Light Control Sensor
CLTB
L-Y
3
IG1
L-Y
G-W
2
IG1
G-W
Y
1
IG1
Y
1
CLTE
3
CLTS
4
21
B6 CLTE
4
B6 CLTS
Driver Side J/B Assembly
I18 Ignition SW
2 AM1
6
B6 CLTB
IG1 4
L-Y
3
W-G
ACC
2
1C
ECU-IG
5
1D
ACC
10
22
SIG
ACC
Engine Room R/B
AM1
W-L
2
B
2
ALT
1 2
1
2
2
B
2
W-B
Light Control SW
W-B
G-O
10
IH1
G-O
3
B6 A
16
12
EL A C12
Combination SW
OFF
AUTO
A J/C A
J15
J15
W-B
LI
A
J5
J/C
Battery
IG
E072982E01
LI–26
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK LIGHTS
(a) Check that headlight and taillight light up.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
2
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect light control switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is a continuity between terminals at
each switch position as shown in the chart.
Standard
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
I033101
NG
TAIL
14 - 16
Continuity
HEAD
13 - 16 - 14
Continuity
AUTO
16 - 12
Continuity
REPLACE HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
3
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Measure voltage between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
(b) Check the continuity between terminal 3 (CLTE) and
body ground as shown in the chart below.
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check that signal waveform
appears between terminals.
E065750
LI
Standard voltage
Terminal No. (Symbol)
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 (CLTB)
1-3
Constant
10 to 14 V
3 (CLTE)
3 - Body ground
Constant
Continuity
IG SW ON
Dimmer SW AUTO
Signal waveform appears
depending on outside
brightness
4 (CLTS)
4-3
NG
REPLACE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL
SENSOR
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–27
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN BODY ECU AND AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL SENSOR)
(a) Check that signal waveform appears between terminals
B6-4 (CLTS) and B6-21 (CLTE) of the multiplex network
body ECU.
Standard:
Bar appears
(b) Measure voltage between terminals B6-6 (CLTB) and
B6-21 (CLTE) of the multiplex network body ECU.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
(c) Check the continuity between terminal B6-21 (CLTE) of
the multiplex network body ECU and body ground.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
LI
LIGHTING: LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Vehicle Exterior
Section: Lighting (ext)
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000024JQ001X
Title: LIGHTING: LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
LIGHTING: LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
LIGHTING: LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
LI–28
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Illumination Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
W
B
8
LSSR
W-R
7
IP1
B-W
W
10
BA1
W
10
BB1
W
LSSR
D19
6
Door Lock Detection
SW Front RH
D21
Door Lock Detection SW Rear RH
W
LSSR
DOOR
R-W
16
1L
9
W
1A
W
W
2
W
OFF
1
I20 Interior Light
5
LSR
15
1K
6
L2 Luggage Compartment Light
Driver Side J/B
6
1E
22
1J
21
B4 LSWD
30
B4 LSWP
D20
Door Lock Detection SW Rear LH
7
LSSR
D16
Door Lock Detection
SW Front LH
7
IA1
8
1A
13
ILE
W
3
ON
DOOR
2
W
J6
J/C
R
E
3
R
R-G
2
2
R
2
R
B
2
5
3
2
DOME
1
2
1
2
2
Short Pin
1
2
ACC AM1
W-L
2
2
2
2
1
2
22
ACC
3
1
R
B4 LMRY
IC3
23
A14
BR-R
IE1
B4 MPX2
BR-R
2
9
R
BD1
B
1
ACC
W
ALT
W-G
Battery
R
2
AM1
9
1K
5
1D
Driver Side J/B
2
I18 Ignition SW
3
6
R-W
Engine Room R/B
DOME
R
LI
I17 Ignition Key
Cylinder Light
ON
B J/C C
J12
J13
R
E
OFF
1
2
1
B8 MPX2
B7 Back Door Lock
Detection SW
LS3
BR-W
4
8
B9 POS
Multiplex Network
Door ECU
I044307E01
LI–29
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK LIGHTS
(a) Check the condition A or B, when room light assembly
No. 1 does not light up.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Door Lock → Door Unlock
A
IG Switch ACC → OFF
B
B
Go to step 10
A
2
CHECK DOOR LOCK
(a) Check which door light does not light up.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Driver side door
A
Passenger side door
B
Rear door
C
Back door
D
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 7
D
Go to step 9
A
3
CHECK FRONT DOOR WITH MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check the continuity between terminal 8 (LSSR) of front
door with motor lock assembly LH and body ground.
Standard
Door lock position
Specified condition
Lock
No continuity
Unlock
Continuity
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT DOOR WITH MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
LI
LI–30
4
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN BODY ECU AND FRONT DOOR WITH
MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check the continuity between terminal 8 (LSSR) of the
front door with motor door lock assembly LH and B4-21
(LSWD) of the multiplex network body ECU.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
5
CHECK FRONT DOOR WITH MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Check the continuity between terminal 7 (LSSR) of the
front door with motor lock assembly RH and body
ground.
Standard
Door lock position
Specified condition
Lock
No continuity
Unlock
Continuity
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR WITH MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
OK
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN BODY ECU AND FRONT DOOR WITH
MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check the continuity between terminal 7 (LSSR) of the
front door with motor door lock assembly RH and B4-30
(LSWP) of the multiplex network body ECU.
Standard:
There is continuity
LI
NG
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
LI–31
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
7
CHECK REAR DOOR LOCK
(a) Check which door light does not light up.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals when unlocking the
door.
Standard
Malfunction part
Tester connection
Specified condition
Rear door LH
6 (LSSR) - Body ground
No continuity → Continuity
Rear door RH
6 (LSSR) - Body ground
No continuity → Continuity
NG
REPLACE REAR DOOR LOCK
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND
REAR DOOR LOCK)
(a) Check the continuity between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
Standard
Malfunction part
Tester connection
Condition
Rear door LH
1L-16 (LSR) - Rear door lock LH
Continuity
Rear door RH
1K-15 (LSR) - Rear door lock RH
Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
9
CHECK WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure voltage between terminal 4 (LS3) of with motor
back door lock assembly and body ground.
Standard
Door lock position
Specified condition
Lock
No continuity
Unlock
Continuity
NG
E065741
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
REPLACE WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY
LI
LI–32
10
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(a) Measure voltage between terminal 1D-5 (ACC) of the
driver side junction block and body ground.
Standard voltage
IG SW
Specified condition
ACC
10 to 14 V
OFF
Below 1 V
OK
Go to step 12
NG
11
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND
IGNITION SWITCH)
(a) Check the continuity between terminal 1D-5 (ACC) of the
driver side junction block and the ignition switch
assembly.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
12
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (ILE)
(a) Measure voltage between terminals as shown in the
chart below when turning the ignition switch to OFF.
Standard voltage
LI
Item
Tester connection
Specified condition
Transponder key amplifier
(Ignition key cylinder light)
1K-9 (ILE) - Body ground
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
Room light assembly No. 1, No. 2
(Interior light, Luggage compartment
Light)
1A-8 (ILE) - Body ground
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
OK
13
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND
LIGHT)
(a) Disconnect the connector of the driver side junction
block.
LI–33
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
(b) Check the continuity between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
Standard
Item
Tester connection
Specified condition
Transponder key amplifier
1K-9 (ILE) - Transponder key amplifier
Continuity
Room light assembly No. 1, No. 2
1A-8 (ILR) - Room light assembly
Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
14
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER (IGNITION KEY CYLINDER LIGHT)
(a) Check the continuity between terminals of transponder
key amplifier (ignition key cylinder light).
Standard:
There is continuity.
NG
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
OK
15
CHECK ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY NO.1
(a) Check the continuity between terminals of the room light
assembly No. 1.
Standard:
There is continuity.
NG
REPLACE ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY NO.1
OK
REPLACE ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY NO.2
LI
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–57
HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
WITHOUT REAR SPOILER
CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
- CENTER STOP LIGHT BULB
LI
B120201E01
LI–58
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
5 Claws
1.
REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (without
Rear Spoiler)
(a) Release the 5 fitting claws as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the center
stop light assembly.
2.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (with
Rear Spoiler)
3.
REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (with
Rear Spoiler)
(a) Disconnect the connector.
I033438E01
I034339
(b) Install the strap on the connector of center stop light
assembly.
Strap
I033910E02
(c) Remove the 2 screws.
(d) Pass the connector through the inside the rear
spoiler sub-assembly and remove the center stop
light assembly with bracket.
HINT:
Leave the strap inside the rear spoiler subassembly.
LI
I033439
(e) Remove the 2 nuts and center stop light assembly.
I033440
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
4.
LI–59
REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT BULB (without Rear
Spoiler)
(a) Remove the center stop light socket and center stop
light bulb as shown in the illustration.
(b) Remove the center stop light bulb from the center
stop light socket.
I033441
LI
LI–34
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Taillight Relay Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Driver Side J/B Assembly
L-W
G
To Another Illumination System
TAIL
1
1C
5
1L
1
2 18
5
3
F3 Front Parking Light LH
W-B
TAIL
G
9
1B
G
11
1B
2
1
F4 Front Parking Light RH
W-B
2
J/C
1
J39
J/C
R14 Rear Combination Light LH
A
J40
G
W-B
6
Tail
TRLY
G
B
4
B
13
1F
R15 Rear Combination Light RH
A
J40
A
W-B
J41
A
J40
G
W-B
6
W-B
Tail
4
2
BD1
G
B
B
G
RH
W-B
G
3
14
T EL
8
IH1
OFF
Tail
16
2
BH1
B10
License Plate Light
10
3
W-B
BD1
BH1
C12
Combination SW
G
W-B
LH
4
8
B6 TAIL
G
A J/C A
J15
J15
W-B
W-B
W-B
W-B
Engine Room R/B
LI
L-W
J/B
2
2
B
Battery
ALT
2
2
1 2
1
A
J5
J/C
B
2
EB
EA
BL
IG
E064839E01
LI–35
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK LIGHTS
(a) Check the condition A, B or C, when taillight does not
light up.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
All
A
Parking light only
B
Combination light only
C
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 7
A
2
INSPECT TAILLIGHT RELAY
(a) Inspect taillight relay continuity.
Standard
B016200
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1-2
Continuity
Constant
3-5
No continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2
3-5
Continuity
NG
REPLACE TAILLIGHT RELAY
OK
3
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect light control switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is continuity between terminals at
each switch position as shown in the chart.
Standard
I033101
OK
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
TAIL
16 - 16
Continuity
NG
REPLACE HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
LI
LI–36
4
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN BODY ECU AND HEADLIGHT DIMMER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check the continuity between terminal B6-8 (TAIL) of the
multiplex network body ECU and the headlight dimmer
switch assembly.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
5
INSPECT LH HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY (PARKING LIGHT)
(a) Check that there is a continuity between terminals of
headlight assembly.
Standard:
ON:
Continuity
OFF:
No continuity
OK
REPLACE LH HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
NG
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND
LH HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check the continuity between the terminal parking light
assembly and driver side junction block.
Standard
Item
LI
Tester connection
Specified condition
Parking lamp LH
1 - 1B-9
Continuity
Parking lamp RH
1 - 1B-11
Continuity
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
7
LI–37
INSPECT REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check that there is a continuity between terminals of rear
combination light assembly.
Standard:
ON:
Continuity
OFF:
No continuity
OK
REPLACE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT
ASSEMBLY LH
NG
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BETWEEN DRIVER SIDE J/B AND REAR
COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check the continuity terminals 4 of the combination light
and 1F-13 of the driver side junction block.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
LI
LI–60
LIGHTING – PERSONAL LIGHT ASSEMBLY
PERSONAL LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
E057880
LI
INSPECT ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 5 when the switch is operated.
Standard:
ON:
Continuity
OFF:
No continuity
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–37
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 10 clips and
radiator support seal upper.
4.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER FILLER
(a) Remove the clip and the front bumper filler.
5.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
E116117
E116118
(b) Remove the bolt, 3 screws, and the headlight
assembly.
E116119
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT NO. 1 BULB
(a) Remove the headlight No. 1 bulb as shown in the
illustration.
LI
E116241
LI–38
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT NO. 2 BULB
(a) Remove the headlight No. 2 bulb as shown in the
illustration.
3.
REMOVE FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
(a) Remove the front turn signal light bulb as shown in
the illustration.
4.
REMOVE CLEARANCE LIGHT BULB
(a) Remove the clearance light bulb as shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
• Since the low-beam light and the high-beam light
are a unit, if the aim on one is correct, the other
should also be correct. However, check both
beams just to make sure.
• Alignment distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
The cutoff line is 101 mm (3.97 in.) above and
below the H line as well as left and right of the V
line with low-beam (SAE J599).
• Alignment distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
The cutoff line is 40 mm (1.57 in.) above and
below the H line as well as left and right of the V
line with low-beam (SAE J599).
• Alignment distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
The cutoff line is 101 mm (3.97 in.) above and
below the H line as well as left and right of the V
line with high-beam (SAE J599).
• Alignment distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
The cutoff line is 40 mm (1.57 in.) above and
below the H line as well as left and right of the V
line with high-beam (SAE J599).
• Alignment distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
The cutoff line is 53 mm (2.08 in.) below the H
line with low-beam.
• Alignment distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
The cutoff line is 21 mm (0.82 in.) below the H
line with low-beam.
E116121
E116122
E116123
LI
LI–61
LIGHTING – ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
E050228
INSPECT NO. 1 ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals at
each switch position as shown in the chart.
Standard
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
DOOR
1-2
Continuity
ON
1-3
Continuity
LI
LI–66
LIGHTING – STEP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
LI
INSPECT STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals
when the courtesy light switch is operated.
Standard:
ON:
Continuity
OFF:
No continuity
LIGHTING – STEP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–67
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STEP LIGHT BULB
2.
INSTALL STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
LI
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
LI–69
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER (See
page SR-21)
3.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER (See
page SR-21)
LI
LI–62
LIGHTING – REAR ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REAR ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
E050228
LI
INSPECT NO. 2 ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals at
each switch position as shown in the chart.
Standard
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
DOOR
1-2
Continuity
ON
1-3
Continuity
LIGHTING – DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
LI–63
DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COURTESY LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals
when the switch is operated.
Standard:
ON (When shaft is pressed):
No continuity
OFF (When shaft is not pressed):
Continuity
LI
LI–64
LIGHTING – STEP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
STEP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
LI
C131564E02
LIGHTING – STEP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–65
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and side step light assembly.
2.
REMOVE STEP LIGHT BULB
I034337
LI
LI–66
LIGHTING – GLOVE BOX LIGHT
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
INSPECTION
1.
LI
INSPECT GLOVE BOX LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals
when the switch is operated.
Standard:
ON (When shaft is pressed):
No continuity
OFF (When shaft is not pressed):
Continuity
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
LI–67
HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
STEERING COLUMN
UPPER COVER
HEADLIGHT DIMMER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER
LI
C131331E06
LI–68
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER (See
page SR-9)
2.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER
3.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and headlight dimmer switch
assembly.
I033442
INSPECTION
1.
I033101
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the light control switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is continuity between
terminals at each switch position as shown in
the chart.
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
TAIL
14 - 6
Continuity
HEAD
13 - 16 - 14
Continuity
AUTO
16 - 12
Continuity
(b) Inspect the headlight dimmer switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is continuity between
terminals at each switch position as shown in
the chart.
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
FLASH
7 - 8 - 16
Continuity
LOW BEAM
16 - 17
Continuity
HI BEAM
7 - 16
Continuity
(c) Inspect the turn signal switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is continuity between
terminals at each switch position as shown in
the chart.
LI
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
Right turn
2-3
Continuity
Neutral
-
No continuity
Left turn
1-2
Continuity
(d) Inspect the front fog light switch continuity.
(1) Check that there is continuity between
terminals at each switch position as shown in
the chart.
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
ON
10 - 11
Continuity
LI–70
LIGHTING – HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
E065753
INSPECT HAZARD WARNING SIGNAL SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there is continuity between terminals at
each switch position as shown in the chart.
Switch operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
2-3
No continuity
ON
2-3
Continuity
Illumination circuit
4-5
Continuity
(b) Inspect illumination operation.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal
4 and the battery negative (-) lead to terminal 5,
then check that the illumination lights up.
LI
LI–71
LIGHTING – STOP LIGHT SWITCH
4
3
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
1
Free
2
Pushed in
E065594E50
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the continuity between terminals at each
switch position, as shown in the chart.
Standard
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1-2
No continuity
Switch pin free
3-4
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
No continuity
LI
LI–72
LIGHTING – TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSEMBLY
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
E015683
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSEMBLY
(without Daytime Running Light)
(a) Measure voltage between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Ground
Turn ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
1 - Ground
Turn ignition switch OFF
No voltage
4 - Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 - Ground
Constant
Continuity
(b) Connect the connector to the turn signal flasher, and
turn the ignition switch to ON, and inspect the wire
harness side connector from the back side as
shown in the chart.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
2 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
3 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
3 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
5 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
6 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
8 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
2.
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSEMBLY (with
Daytime Running Light)
(a) Measure voltage between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
LI
E064832
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
9 - Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 - Ground
Turn ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
1 - Ground
Turn ignition switch OFF
No voltage
6 - Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
LI–73
LIGHTING – TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSEMBLY
(b) Connect the connector to the turn signal flasher and
turn the ignition switch to ON, and inspect the wire
harness side connector from the back side as
shown in the chart.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
2 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
2 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) ON → OFF
10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per minutes) →
10 to 14 V
3 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
3 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
4 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
4 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
4 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) ON → OFF
10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per minutes) →
10 to 14 V
5 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
5 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per
minutes)
7 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
8 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
10 - Ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
LI
LI–74
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT RELAY
HEADLIGHT RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
E064835
INSPECT HEADLIGHT RELAY
(a) Remove the headlight relay.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and
2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the headlight
relay.
LI
LI–75
LIGHTING – TAILLIGHT RELAY
TAILLIGHT RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
B113729
INSPECT TAILLIGHT RELAY
(a) Remove the taillight relay.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and
2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the taillight
relay.
LI
LIGHTING – TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
LI–81
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
3.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR (See page IR-7)
4.
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-7)
5.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page IR-7)
6.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX RH (See page IR-8)
7.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page IR-8)
8.
REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR (See page IR-8)
9.
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH (See
page IR-8)
10. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-9)
11. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH (See page IR-10)
12. REMOVE TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and towing converter relay.
I033447
LI
LI–82
LIGHTING – TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH (See page IR-16)
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-16)
4.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH (See
page IR-18)
5.
INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
6.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page IR-18)
7.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX RH (See page IR-18)
8.
INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page IR-18)
9.
INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-18)
10. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
(See page IR-18)
11. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
12. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
LI
LI–76
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT RELAY
FOG LIGHT RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
B113729
INSPECT FOG LIGHT RELAY
(a) Remove the fog light relay.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and
2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the fog light
relay.
LI
LIGHTING – TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
LI–77
TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
LI
E115633E02
LI–78
LIGHTING – TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
DECK FLOOR BOX RH
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
LI
B120186E03
LIGHTING – TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
LI–79
BACK DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP
REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER LH
DECK TRIM SIDE
PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
LI
B120187E03
LI–80
LIGHTING – TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
(a) Measure voltage between terminals as shown in the
chart below.
E064833
LI
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
2 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per minutes)
2 - Ground
Depress the brake pedal
Battery positive voltage
3 - Ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per minutes)
4 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per minutes)
4 - Ground
Depress the brake pedal
Battery positive voltage
6 - Ground
Constant
Continuity
8 - Ground
Depress the brake pedal
Battery positive voltage
9 - Ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 time per minutes)
WW–3
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
FRONT WIPER ARM
AND BLADE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ROOM R/B
ALT FUSE
AMI FUSE
J/B FUSE
WASHER MOTOR
WW
C131566E01
WW–4
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
MULTIPLEX NETWORK
DOOR ECU BACK
REAR WIPER ARM AND
BLADE ASSEMBLY
REAR WIPER MOTOR
WW
B120207E01
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–5
WIPER SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
FR WIP-WSH FUSE
WW
B120208E01
WW–6
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM:
Symptom
Suspected Area
1. FR WIP-WSH Fuse
Front wiper and washer systems do not operate (All).
-
2. Windshield wiper switch assembly
3. Harness or connector
Front wiper system does not operate.
WW-38
-
1. Windshield wiper switch assembly
WW-38
2. Front wiper motor assembly
WW-24
3. Harness or connector
Front washer system does not operate.
See page
-
1. Windshield wiper switch assembly
WW-38
2. Front washer motor assembly
WW-40
3. Harness or connector
-
REAR WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM:
Symptom
Rear wiper and washer systems do not operate (All).
Rear wiper system does not operate.
Rear washer system does not operate.
WW
Suspected Area
1. ALT, AMI ECU-IG Fuse
See page
-
2. Wiper and washer switch circuit
WW-13
1. Wiper and washer switch circuit
WW-13
2. Rear wiper motor circuit
WW-10
1. Wiper and washer switch circuit
WW-13
2. Washer motor circuit
WW-18
WW–7
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
Multiplex Network Body Computer
Front side:
1A
1F
B6
B5
B4
1E
1C
1D
1B
Back side:
1G
1J
1L
1K
WW
1H
I034371E01
WW–8
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Standard voltage
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring color
Condition
1B-1 - 1H-2
(WMTR - GND1, 2)
-
Rear washer switch OFF → ON
1H-2 - Body ground
(GND1 - Body ground)
-
Constant
1C-2 - 1H-2
(SIG - GND1, 2)
-
Ignition switch is OFF → ON
1H-2 - Body Ground
(GND2 - Body ground)
-
Constant
Specified condition
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
Below 1 V
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
B4-23 - 1H-2
(MPX2 - GND1, 2)
BR-R - -
Ignition switch is ON
B6-9 - 1H-2
(RWINT - GND1, 2)
BR-W - -
Ignition switch is ON and rear wiper switch is OFF
→ INT
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
B6-10 - 1H-2
RWON - GND1, 2)
GR-R - -
Ignition switch is ON and rear wiper switch is OFF
→ ON
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
2.
Signal waveform
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back:
B9
B8
I033329E02
Standard voltage
Terminal No. (Symbols)
WW
Wiring color
Condition
Specified condition
B8-1- B8-3
(MPX2 - GND)
R - W-B
Ignition switch is ON
B8-3 - Body ground
(GND - Body ground)
W-B - -
Constant
Below 1 V
B8-4 - B8-3
(BDR - GND)
L - W-B
Constant
10 to 14 V
B8-6 - B8-3
(SIG - GND)
B - W-B
Ignition switch is OFF → ON
B9-1 - B8-3
(WIP- - GND)
R-G - W-B
Ignition switch is ON and wiper switch ON or INT
Puls generation
B9-2 - B8-3
(WIP+ - GND)
Y-G - W-B
Ignition switch is ON and wiper switch ON or INT
Puls generation
Signal waveform
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
B9-3 - B8-3
(W - GND)
BR-B - W-B
Ignition switch is ON
Puls generation
B9-11 - B8-3
(IC+ - GND)
Y-G - W-B
Ignition switch is ON
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
B9-16 - B8-3
(IC1 - GND)
B-O - W-B
Back door power window up and down
Puls generation
B9-17 - B8-3
(IC2 - GND)
W-R - W-B
Back door power window up and down
Puls generation
WW–9
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Terminal No. (Symbols)
B9-23 - B8-3
(IC- - GND)
Wiring color
L-W - W-B
Condition
Constant
Specified condition
Below 1 V
WW
WW–10
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
WIPER TURN SW
Rear wiper turn
position switch
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Rear wiper is turning position
OFF: Rear wiper is other position
-
WIPER RTRCT SW
Rear wiper
retracting switch
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Rear wiper is retract position
OFF: Rear wiper is other position
-
WIPER STOP POS
Rear wiper stop
position signal/ON
or OFF
ON: Rear wiper is stop position
OFF: Rear wiper is other position
-
Normal condition
2.
Item
REAR WIPER
WW
DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the intelligent
tester, you can read the value of the switch, sensor,
actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the
DATA LIST as a first step of troubleshooting is one of the
methods to shorten the labor time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, read the "DATA
LIST".
Diagnostic note
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate
without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
a first step of troubleshooting is one of the methods to
shorten the labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, perform the
"ACTIVE TEST".
Test Details
Rear wiper ON/OFF
Diagnostic Note
-
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–11
Rear Wiper Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
• This circuit provides power to operate the combination switch.
• Perform this inspection with the back door window glass fully closed.
WW
WW–12
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
R
G
B11
Back Door Power
Window Motor
SSRB
PLS2
PLS
E
R23
Rear Wiper Motor Rear
Wiper Position SW
4
Y-B
5
R-B
1
Y-G
6
B-O
2
W-R
3
L-W
2
G-R
1
P-B
3
BR-B
5
Y-G
4
R-G
ECU-IG
2
1C
L-Y
2 AM1 IG1 4
POWER
1
1C
L-W
B
1C2
ICSGND
P
W
WIP+
WIP-
1
B8 MPX2
8
1F
B-R
5
BD1
B
6
B8 SIG
2
1F
L-O
6
BD1
L
4
B8 BDR
W-B
10
BD1
W-B
3
B8 GND
2
2 AM1 1
A
J40
ALT
2
2
1C1
R
J/B
2
2
1C+
9
BD1
2
1
Engine Room R/B
W-L
BDDN
Driver Side J/B Assembly
I18
Ignition SW
L-W
18
B9
12
B9
3
B9
2
B9
1
B9
BDUP
BR-R
Multiplex Network Body ECU
W-L
13
B9
25
B9
11
B9
16
B9
17
B9
23
B9
1
2
J/C
A
W-B
J40
B
1
2
WW
Battery
BO
E065745E01
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–13
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK (BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
MOTOR CIRCUIT)
(a) Inspect the back door power window motor operation
(See page WS-5).
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
OK
2
INSPECT REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure voltage between terminals 4 and 5 of
windshield wiper switch assembly, when rear wiper
switch is ON.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
E034081
NG
3
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK (REAR WIPER MOTOR CIRCUIT)
(a) Measure voltage between terminals B9-1 (WIP-) and B92 (WIP+) of multiplex network door ECU back, when rear
wiper switch is ON.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NG
REPLACE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–1
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION OF WASHER NOZZLE ADJUSTMENT
(a) Do not clean or adjust the washer nozzle with a
safety pin etc. because;
(1) the washer nozzle tip is made of resin and could
be damaged.
(2) adjustment is not necessary because the
washer nozzle is spray type.
(b) In case the washer nozzle is clogged with wax etc.,
remove the objects and clean the nozzle hole with a
soft resin brush etc.
WW
WW–2
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORK SHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
4
TERMINAL OF ECU
NEXT
5
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
6
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
WW
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
WW–14
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Wiper and Washer Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
• This circuit provides power to operate the combination switch.
• Perform this inspection with the back door window glass fully closed.
WW
WW–15
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Driver Side J/B Assembly
I18
Ignition SW
ECU-IG
W-L
2
1C
L-Y
2 AM1
IG1 4
LG-B
1
1B
B-O
M
4
3
W2
Washer Motor
10
W-B
2
2
1H
16
3 IC3
4
GR-R
LG-B
BR-W
12
SIG
WMTR
GND2
GND1
6
IH1
GR-R
10
B6 RWON
7
IH1
BR-W
9
B6 RWINT
10 13
WR EW +1R C1R
C14
Combination SW
Washer
OFF
INT
ON
Washer
2
W-B
A J/C
J15
J15
W-B
W-B
Engine Room R/B
W-L
B
AM1
ALT
2
2
2
2
12
1
B
2
A
J5
J/C
Battery
A
WW
IG
E065742E01
WW–16
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
(a) Check the condition A, B or C, when rear wiper or rear
washer system does not operate.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Rear wiper and washer systems do
not operate.
A
Rear wiper system does not operate.
B
Rear washer system does not
operate.
C
B
Go to step 4
C
Go to step 6
A
2
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the continuity of the windshield wiper switch
assembly.
Rear Wiper Switch
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No Continuity
INTO
2 (EW) - 13 (C1R)
Continuity
ON
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R)
Continuity
Rear Washer Switch
E034825
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
ON (OFF position side)
2 (EW) - 12 (WR)
Continuity
ON (ON position side)
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R) - 12
(WR)
Continuity
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals 2 (EW) of
windshield wiper switch assembly and body ground.
Standard:
There is continuity
NG
WW
REPLACE WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
3
INSPECT DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (SIG)
(a) Measure the voltage between terminals 1C-2 and 1H-2
of driver side junction block when ignition key is ON.
WW–17
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Standard voltage
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
1C-2 (SIG) - 1H-2 (GND)
Below 1 V
ON
1C-2 (SIG) - 1H-2 (GND)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH REAR
4
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the continuity the windshield wiper switch
assembly.
Rear Wiper Switch
E034825
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No Continuity
INTO
2 (EW) - 13 (C1R)
Continuity
ON
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R)
Continuity
NG
REPLACE WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
5
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
(a) Check the continuity terminals multiplex network body
ECU and body ground, when rear wiper switch operated.
Standard resistance
Switch position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
INT
B6-9 (RWINT) - Body ground
No continuity → Continuity
ON
B6-10 (RWON) - Body ground
No continuity → Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
WW
WW–18
6
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the continuity the windshield wiper switch
assembly.
Rear Washer Switch
E034825
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
ON (OFF position side)
2 (EW) -12 (WR)
Continuity
ON (ON position side)
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R) - 12
(WR)
Continuity
NG
REPLACE WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
INSPECT DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(a) Check the continuity terminals driver side junction block
and body ground, when rear washer switch operated.
Standard resistance
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
ON (OFF position side)
1B-1 (WMTR) - Body ground
No continuity → Continuity
ON (ON position side)
1B-1 (WMTR) - Body ground
No continuity → Continuity
NG
REPLACE REAR WASHER MOTOR AND
PUMP ASSEMBLY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
WW–21
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
FR WIPER ARM RH
FR WIPER ARM LH
FRONT FENDER TO COWL SIDE SEAL RH
COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB- ASSEMBLY
WW
FRONT FENDER TO COWL SIDE SEAL LH
B120221E03
WW–22
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
AND LINK
- WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ROOM R/B
ALT FUSE
AMI FUSE
J/B FUSE
WINDSHIELD WASHER MOTOR AND PUMP ASSEMBLY
WW
C131566E02
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
WW–23
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
(a) Using a small screwdriver, remove the 2 front wiper
arm head cap.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH
(a) Operate the wiper and stop the windshield wiper
motor assembly at the automatic stop position.
(b) Remove a nut and FR wiper arm RH.
3.
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH
(a) Remove a nut and FR wiper arm LH.
4.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER TO COWL SIDE SEAL LH
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Release the 2 claws, and remove the front fender to
cowl side seal LH.
5.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER TO COWL SIDE SEAL RH
6.
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 clips.
(b) Using a clipremover, disengage the meshing of 6
clips.
I033031
: Clip
2 Claws
I033032E02
6 Clips
I033033E01
(c) Remove the 9 claws and cowl top ventilator louver
sub-assembly.
9 Claws
I033034E01
WW
WW–24
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
7.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
(a) Disconnect the connector and remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Slide the wiper link assembly to vehicle's
passenger's side. Disengage the meshing of the
rubber pin and remove the wiper link assembly.
8.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver and disengage the meshing of
2 rods at the clank arm pivot of the windshield wiper
motor assembly.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
I033035
E066043
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and windshield wiper motor
assembly.
I033038
INSPECTION
WW
1.
E034081
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) LO Operation Check
(1) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 1 (+1) of the
connector, the battery (-) to terminal 5 (E) of the
connector, and check that the motor operates
with low speed (LO).
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
WW–25
(b) HI Operation Check
(1) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 4 (+2) of the
connector, the battery (-) to terminal 5 (E) of the
connector, and check that the motor operates
with high speed (HI).
(c) Automatic Stop Operation Check
(1) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 1 (+1) of the
connector, the battery (-) to terminal 5 (E) of the
connector. With the motor being rotated at low
speed (LO), disconnect terminal 1 (+1) to stop
the wiper motor operation at any position
except the automatic stop position.
(2) Using a SST, connect terminal 1 (+1) and 3 (S),
and the battery (+) to terminal 2 (B) to restart
the motor operation at low speed.
SST 09843-18040
(3) Check the automatic stop position.
Standard:
See the illustration.
Automatic Stop Position
E065740E02
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–19
Washer Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
• This circuit provides power to operate the combination switch.
• Perform this inspection with the back door window glass fully closed.
WW
WW–20
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
13
B9
BDUP
Y-B
BDDN
IC+
IC1
IC2
R
4
25
B9
11
B9
16
B9
17
B9
R-B
G
5
Y-G
SSRB
1
B-O
PLS2
6
W-R
PLS
2
23
IC- B9
1
MPX2 B8
L-W
E
3
9
BD1
R
B11
Back Door Power
Window Motor
A14
IE1
BR-R
I18 Ignition SW
W-L
2 AM1
L-Y
IG1 4
LG-B
IC3
LG-B
4
3
W2
Washer Motor
12
WR EW
B-O
M
2
1C
1
1B
2
1H
C14
Combination SW
Washer
OFF
2
W-B
A J/C A
J15
J15
BR-R
23
B4 MPX2
ECU-IG
10
2
16
4
SIG
WMTR
GND2
GND1
W-B
Engine Room R/B
W-L
B
AM1
W-B
ALT
2
2
2
2
1 2
B
1
2
A
J5
J/C
WW
Battery
A
IG
E065746E01
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–21
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK (BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
MOTOR CIRCUIT)
(a) Inspect the back door power window motor operation
(See page WS-5).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER RUBBER
WW–27
FRONT WIPER RUBBER
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
FRONT WIPER BLADE
FRONT WIPER RUBBER BRACKING PLATE
WIPER RUBBER
FRONT WIPER RUBBER
BACKING PLATE
E101448E06
WW
WW–28
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER RUBBER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER BLADE
(a) Remove the front wiper blade from the front wiper
arm.
NOTICE:
Do not fold down the front wiper arm with the
front wiper blade being remove from it.
2.
REMOVE WIPER RUBBER
(a) Remove the front wiper rubber from the front wiper
blade.
(b) Remove the 2 wiper rubber backing plates from the
wiper rubber.
INSTALLATION
Curve
1.
INSTALL WIPER RUBBER
(a) Install the 2 wiper rubber backing plates to the wiper
rubber.
NOTICE:
Be careful to observe and keep direction of
curvature for correct replacement.
E059361E15
(b) Install the wiper rubber so that the head part (Larger
side) of the wiper rubber faces the arm axis side.
NOTICE:
Push the front wiper blade into the grooves of
the wiper rubber to engage them completely.
E057398
WW
WW–26
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
INSTALLATION
Wiper Arm
Serration
1.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply MP grease to the clank arm pivot of the
windshield wiper motor assembly.
(b) Install the windshield wiper motor assembly with 2
bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
(a) Install the meshing of the rubber pin.
(b) Install the windshield wiper link assembly with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 7 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the connector.
3.
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH
(a) Operate the wiper, and stop the windshield wiper
motor assembly at the automatic stop position.
(b) Scrape off the serration part of the wiper arm with a
round file or equivalent.
(c) Clean the wiper pivot serration with the wire brush.
Wire Brush
Wiper Pivot
Serration
E058837E24
(d) Install the front wiper arm LH with a nut to the
position shown in the illustration.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18.4 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Hold down the arm hinge with hand to fasten a nut.
Installation Position Mark
WW
I034372E01
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR
4.
Installation Position Mark
I034373E01
WW–27
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH
(a) Scrape off the serration part of the wiper arm with a
round file or equivalent.
(b) Clean the wiper pivot serration with the wire brush.
(c) Install the front wiper arm RH with a nut at the
position shown in the illustration.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18.4 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Hold down the arm hinge with hand to fasten a nut.
(d) Operate the wiper while running the water or the
washer fluid over the window, and check the wiping
condition and that the rear wiper does not hit
against the vehicle body.
WW
WW–29
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
REAR WIPER MOTOR
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR WIPER ARM
REAR WIPER MOTOR GROMMET
WW
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120202E01
WW–30
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
WW
BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD
Non-reusable part
B120203E01
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
WW–31
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
WW
B120207E02
WW–32
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
REMOVAL
4 Claws
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD (See page ED53)
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(See page ED-53)
3.
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
(a) Release the 4 claws and remove the rear wiper arm
head cap.
4.
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM
(a) Remove a nut and rear wiper arm.
5.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR GROMMET
6.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 grommets.
I033023E01
I033024
(b) Remove the 3 bolts.
I033025
(c) Using a clipremover, remove the clamp.
(d) Disconnect the connector and remove the rear
wiper motor assembly.
WW
I033026
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
WW–33
INSPECTION
1.
E034081
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Operation Check
(1) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 4 of the rear
wiper motor assembly, the battery (-) to
terminal 5 of the rear wiper motor assembly.
Check that the motor turns clockwise.
(2) Reverse the polarity, and check that the motor
turns counterclockwise.
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER RUBBER
WW–35
REAR WIPER RUBBER
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
REAR WIPER BLADE
REAR WIPER RUBBER
REAR WIPER RUBBER
BACKING PLATE
REAR WIPER RUBBER
BACKING PLATE
E110466E05
REMOVAL
1.
60°
E060751E02
REMOVE REAR WIPER BLADE
(a) Raise the rear wiper blade to the position as shown
in the illustration, to the extent that the meshing of
the claw is disengaged with the click sound.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to break the claw.
(b) Pull straight the rear wiper blade to vehicle's left
from the wiper arm.
NOTICE:
Do not fold the rear wiper arm with the rear
wiper blade being removed from it.
WW
WW–36
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER RUBBER
2.
Push
Pull
Stopper
E060704E06
REMOVE REAR WIPER RUBBER
(a) Place the rear wiper with the rear end of the rubber
protruded from the blade stopper as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not pull out the wiper rubber forcibly.
Otherwise the backing plates are deformed or
blade claw is damaged.
HINT:
Pushing the position close to the middle of the blade
will raise the rubber, which could be easier to pull it
out.
INSTALLATION
Curve
1.
INSTALL REAR WIPER RUBBER
(a) Install the 2 wiper rubber backing plates to the rear
wiper rubber.
NOTICE:
Be careful to observe and keep direction of
curvature for correct replacement.
E059361E15
(b) Insert the rear wiper rubber from the claw of the
middle of the rear wiper blade into the rear end
position.
(c) After passing the rear wiper rubber through the rear
end side claw, protrude it from the rear end stopper
and pass it through the front tip side claw.
I034384
WW
WW–34
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear wiper motor assembly with 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the clamp and connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR GROMMET
(a) As shown in the illustration, install the rear wiper
motor grommet with it is position mark upside.
3.
INSTALL REAR WIPER ARM
(a) Scrape off the serration part of the wiper arm with a
round file or equivalent.
(b) Clean the rear wiper pivot serration with the wire
brush.
(c) Stop the rear wiper motor assembly at the automatic
stop position.
Installation
Position Mark
Rear Wiper Grommet
I033027E01
Wiper Arm
Serration
Wire Brush
Wiper Pivot
Serration
E058837E24
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
WW–35
(d) Hold the slider to the position "A" and install the arm
& blade assembly with the nut temporally.
(e) Move the slider to the position "B" and tighten the
nut to install the arm & blade assembly.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Hold down the arm hinge with hand to fasten a nut.
(f) Set the arm & blade assembly by moving it back to
the rise-up position.
(g) Operate the rear wiper while running the water or
the washer fluid over the window, and check the
wiping condition and that the rear wiper does not hit
against the vehicle body.
Position A:
Position B:
4.
I033028E01
INSTALL BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(See page ED-60)
WW
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
WW–37
WIPER SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
WINDSHIELD WIPER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
STEERING
COLUMN COVER
STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER
WW
C131331E05
WW–38
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER (See
page SR-9)
2.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER
3.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
I033194
(b) Remove the 2 screws and windshield wiper switch
assembly.
I033195
INSPECTION
1.
E034825
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Continuity Check
(1) Check the continuity of each terminal of the
connector.
Front Wiper Switch
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
16 (+S) - 7 (+1)
Continuity
INTO
16 (+S) - 7 (+1)
Continuity
LO
17 (+B) - 7 (+1)
Continuity
HI
17 (+B) - 8 (+2)
Continuity
Rear Wiper Switch
WW
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No Continuity
INTO
2 (EW) - 13 (C1R)
Continuity
ON
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R)
Continuity
Front Washer Switch
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No Continuity
ON
11 (WF) - 2 (EW)
Continuity
Rear Washer Switch
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No Continuity
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
WW–39
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
ON (OFF position side)
2 (EW) - 12 (WR)
Continuity
ON (ON position side)
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R) - 12
(WR)
Continuity
(b) Intermittent Operation Check
(1) Connect the voltmeter (+) terminal to terminal 7
(+1) of the connector, the voltmeter (-) terminal
to terminal 2 (EW) of the connector.
(2) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 17 (+B) of
the connector, the battery (-) to terminal 2 (EW)
and 16 (+S) of the connector.
(3) Turn the wiper switch to INT.
(4) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 16 (+S) of
the connector for 5 seconds.
(5) Connect the battery (-) to terminal 16 (+S) of
the connector. Operate the intermittent wiper
relay and check voltage between terminal 7
(+1) and terminal 2 (EW).
FAST: Connect the battery (-) to terminal 16 (+S)
SLOW: Connect the battery (-) to terminal 16 (+S)
7 (+1) - 2 (EW)
Voltage between terminals
1.6 +- 1 seconds
10.7 +- 5 seconds
E056399E32
Washer
Switch
7 (+1) - 2 (EW)
Voltage between
terminals
Approx. 0.3
second
Approx. 2.2
seconds I030007E04
(c) Operation Check (Front Wiper)
(1) Turn the wiper switch to OFF.
(2) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 17 (+B) of
the connector, the battery (-) to terminal 16 (+S)
and 2 (EW) of the connector.
(3) Connect the voltmeter (+) terminal to terminal 7
(+1) of the connector and the voltmeter (-)
terminal to terminal 2 (EW) of the connector.
Turn the washer switch to ON and OFF, and
check voltage between terminal 7 (+1) and
terminal 2 (EW).
WW
WW–40
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
INSTALLATION
WW
1.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER
3.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LOWER
WW–40
WIPER AND WASHER – WASHER MOTOR
WASHER MOTOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
E065747
WW
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WASHER MOTOR AND
PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Operation Check
(1) Pour the washer fluid into the washer jar with
the washer motor and the pump installed to the
washer jar assembly.
(2) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 1 of the
washer motor and the pump, the battery (-) to
terminal 2 of the washer motor and the pump.
Check that the water comes out from the
washer jar.
WW–41
WIPER AND WASHER – WASHER NOZZLE
WASHER NOZZLE
ADJUSTMENT
1.
INSPECT WASHER NOZZLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) With the engine running, check that the point where
the washer fluid hits the windshield is within the
range indicated by the hatched line.
Front:
A
A
A
A
A
A
B
D
C
I
H
J
E
F
G
K
M
O
L
N
P
A: 150 mm (5.91 in.)
I: 384.6 mm (15.142 in.)
B: 30 mm (1.18 in.)
J: 288.2 mm (11.346 in.)
C: 236.5 mm (9.311 in.)
K: 85.2 mm (3.354 in.)
D: 60 mm (2.36 in.)
L: 77.1 mm (3.035 in.)
E: 364.4 mm (14.346 in.)
M: 247 mm (9.72 in.)
F: 240.1 mm (9.453 in.)
N: 366.7 mm (14.437 in.)
G: 207.8 mm (8.181 in.)
O: 568.3 mm (22.374 in.)
H: 60 mm (2.36 in.)
P: 557.2 mm (21.937 in.)
WW
I033029E01
WW–42
WIPER AND WASHER – WASHER NOZZLE
2.
INSPECT REAR WASHER NOZZLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) With the engine running, check the point where the
washer fluid hits the rear window is within the range
indicated by the hatched line.
Rear:
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
A: 114.2 mm (4.496 in.)
B: 60.3 mm (2.374 in.)
C: 107 mm (4.21 in.)
D: 210.4 mm (8.283 in.)
E: 41.6 mm (1.638 in.)
F: 56.4 mm (2.22 in.)
G: 102.7 mm (4.043 in.)
H: 153.8 mm (6.055 in.)
I033030E01
WW
DL–4
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
2.
DL
DOOR LOCK FAIL-SAFE
(a) When a malfunction in the door control switch
(manual switch, interlocked with key operation) has
been detected, door lock/unlock operation becomes
disabled.
CHECK ELECTRICAL DOOR LOCK OPERATION
NOTICE:
The following inspection procedure are based on the
assumption that the vehicle has not been
customized using intelligent tester.
(a) Check the basic function.
(1) Check that all doors lock when the door control
switch (for manual operation) is turned to LOCK
and all doors unlock when turned to UNLOCK.
(2) Check that all doors lock when the driver side
door lock key cylinder is turned to LOCK using
the key.
(3) Check that only the driver side door unlocks
when the driver side door lock key cylinder is
turned to UNLOCK and all doors unlock when
turned to UNLOCK once again within 3 seconds
using the key (2-step unlocking function).
(b) Check the key lock-in prevention function.
NOTICE:
In order to prevent the key from being actually
locked-in, the inspection should be performed
with the driver side door window open.
(1) Have the key inserted into the ignition key
cylinder.
(2) With the driver side door open, check that all
doors unlock immediately after the door lock
knob for the driver side door is turned to LOCK.
(3) With the driver side door open, check that all
doors unlock immediately after the door control
switch (for manual operation) is turned to LOCK.
(4) With the driver side door open, turn the driver
side door lock knob to LOCK and hold it for 2
seconds or more, and then close the driver side
door. Then check that all doors unlock.
(c) Check the security function.
(1) Close all doors with the driver side door window
open so that the door control switch can be
operated from outside the vehicle.
(2) Pull out the key, open the driver side door and
then close and lock the door without using the
key. Under this condition, check that all doors do
not unlock when the door control switch (for
manual operation) is turned to UNLOCK from
outside the vehicle.
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–5
(3) Pull out the key, close and lock the driver side
door by key operation. Under this condition,
check that all doors do not unlock when the door
control switch (for manual operation) is turned to
UNLOCK from outside the vehicle.
(4) Pull out the key, close the driver side door and
lock the door by wireless door lock operation.
Under this condition, check that all doors do not
unlock when the door control switch (for manual
operation) is turned to UNLOCK from outside the
vehicle.
HINT:
Check that the security function is canceled
under the following conditions:
• The ignition switch is turned ON.
• The driver side door is unlocked using the
key.
• The door control switch (for manual
operation) is turned to UNLOCK after the
door control knob is turned to UNLOCK
manually.
• The doors are unlocked by wireless
operation.
(d) Check the illumination function.
(1) Set the interior light switch in the DOOR
position.
(2) With all doors locked, check that all doors unlock
when the driver side door lock cylinder is turned
to UNLOCK using the key. At the same time, the
interior light comes on.
(3) Check that the interior light goes off in
approximately 15 seconds if the doors have not
been opened for a while.
(e) Check the automatic locking function interlocked
with the shift lever.
(1) When any door is unlocked with all doors closed
and the engine started, check that all doors
automatically lock when the shift lever is moved
into any position from the P position.
(2) When any door is unlocked after all doors
automatically lock, check that all doors attempt
to automatically lock once again (retry function).
The retry function is canceled when any of the
following conditions is fulfilled:
• All doors are locked.
• Any door is opened.
• The shift lever is moved into the P position.
• The doors are locked or unlocked by the user.
• The ignition switch is turned OFF.
• The engine is stopped.
DL
DL–6
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM:
Symptom
All doors lock and unlock functions do not operate via
master switch, driver side door key cylinder
Key lock-in prevention function does not work properly
(Manual operation and operation interlocked with key
are active)
Only back door can not be opened (Unlocked)
DL
Suspected area
See page
1. DOOR1 fuse
DL-12
2. ECU-B fuse
DL-12
3. Power window regulator master switch assembly
DL-12
4. Front door lock assembly LH
DL-12
5. Instrument panel junction block assembly (body ECU)
DL-12
6. Wire harness
DL-12
1. Unlock warning switch assembly
DL-17
2. Courtesy light switch assembly LH (Driver side door)
DL-17
3. Instrument panel junction block assembly (body ECU)
DL-17
4. Wire harness
DL-17
1. Back door opener switch assembly
DL-21
2. w/ Motor back door lock assembly LH (Back door lock)
DL-21
3. Instrument panel junction block assembly (body ECU)
DL-21
4. Wire harness
DL-21
DL–7
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
Vehicle Rear Side
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (BODY ECU)
Vehicle Right Side
Vehicle Front Side
1H
1F
B6
1A
1E
1K
B5
1C
B4
1B
1D
1J
1L
1G
Body ECU
1F
B6
1E
1K
1B
1L
B4
DL
B062708E01
DL–8
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Disconnect the 1B, 1E, 1F, 1H, 1K, 1L, B4 and B6 J/
B connectors, and check the voltage or continuity of
each terminal of the vehicle side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
BDR1 (1E-9) - Body Ground
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
G-W - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
W-R - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
GND1 or GND2 (1H-2) - Body
Ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
KSW (B6-14) - Body Ground
G-Y - Body ground
No key inserted in ignition key cylinder → Key inserted
10 kΩ or higher → Below
1Ω
L1(1K-5) - Body Ground
L-W - Body ground
Door control switch (Master switch) OFF → LOCK
10 kΩ or higher → Below
1Ω
UL1 (1K-1) - Body Ground
L-O - Body ground
Door control switch (Master switch) OFF → UNLOCK
10 kΩ or higher → Below
1Ω
L2 (1K-3) - Body Ground
L - Body ground
Driver side door key cylinder OFF → LOCK
10 kΩ or higher → Below
1Ω
UL3 (B4-12) - Body Ground
G - Body ground
Driver side door key cylinder OFF → UNLOCK twice
(within 3 sec.)
10 kΩ or higher → Below
1Ω
BECU (1B-4) - Body Ground
BECU (1F-12) - Body Ground
BECU (1L-4) - Body Ground
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the J/B connectors 1B, 1E, 1F, 1H, 1K,
1L, B4 and B6, and check the voltage of each
terminal of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
DCTY (B5-23) - Body Ground
R-B - Body ground
ACT+ (1L-9) - Body Ground
L-R - Body ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Driver door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
Door control switch (master switch or passenger side
switch) or driver door key cylinder OFF → LOCK
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
Door control switch (master switch or passenger side
switch) or driver door key cylinder OFF → LOCK
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
ACT+ (1L-6) - Body Ground
L-R - Body ground
ACT+ (1L-11) - Body Ground
L-R - Body ground
ACT+ (1L-10) - Body Ground
L-R - Body ground
ACT- (1L-18) - Body Ground
L-B - Body ground
ACT- (1L-23) - Body Ground
L-B - Body ground
ACT- (1L-22) - Body Ground
L-B - Body ground
ACTD (B4-10) - Body Ground
L-B - Body ground
Driver side door key cylinder OFF → 2-step unlocking
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
LSWD (B4-21) - Body Ground
W-R - Body ground
Driver side door UNLOCK → LOCK
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
LSWP (B4-30) - Body Ground
B-W - Body ground
Passenger side door UNLOCK → LOCK
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
LSR (1L-16) - Body Ground
W - Body ground
Rear left door UNLOCK → LOCK
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
LSR (1K-15) - Body Ground
W - Body ground
Rear right door UNLOCK → LOCK
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
If the result is not as specified, the vehicle may be
defective. In this case, check the harness,
connector and fuse between the ECU and battery.
Then repair or replace it if necessary.
DL
DL–9
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
B9
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
(BACK DOOR ECU)
B8
B062706E03
(a) Disconnect the B8 and B9 ECU connectors, and
check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of
the wire harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
BDR (B8-4) - Body Ground
Wiring Color
L - Body ground
Condition
Always
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
BECU (B8-5) - Body Ground
L-R - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (B8-3) - Body Ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SIG (B8-6) - Body Ground
B - Body ground
No key inserted in ignition key cylinder → Key inserted
10 k Ω or higher → Below
1Ω
Back door opener switch OFF → ON
10 k Ω or higher → Below
1Ω
HSW+ (B9-10) - Body Ground
V - W - Body
ground
HSW- (B9-22) - Body Ground
LG-R - Body
ground
HALF (B9-6) - Body Ground
R-G - Body ground
Back door OPEN → CLOSED
10 k Ω or higher → Below
1Ω
LSE (B9-21) - Body Ground
B-R - Body ground
Always
Always
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the connectors, and check the voltage of
each terminal of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
L-B - Body ground
Back door OPEN → NOT COMPLETELY CLOSED →
Motor in normal rotation (Right turn) → Motor in revers
rotation (Left turn) → Operation completed (Back door
CLOSED)
Below 1 V → Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V →
Below 1 V
ACT- (B9-14) - Body Ground
L-R - Body ground
Back door OPEN → NOT COMPLETELY CLOSED →
Motor in normal rotation (Right turn) → Motor in revers
rotation (Left turn) → Operation completed (Back door
CLOSED)
Below 1 V → Below 1 V →
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
FULL (B9-7) - Body Ground
G-Y - Body ground
Back door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
POS (B9-8) - Body Ground
BR-W - Body
ground
Back door OPEN → Closer in operation → CLOSED
Below 1 V 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
ACT+ (B9-15) - Body Ground
If the result is not as specified, the vehicle may be
defective. In this case, check the harness,
connector and fuse between the ECU and battery.
Then repair or replace it if necessary.
DL
DL–10
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
SG
1.
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BAT
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle's body ECU uses ISO 9141-2 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement
of the DLC3 complies with SAEJ1962 and matches
the ISO 9141-2 format.
9 10 11 1213141516
A082779E04
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
(b) Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and
attempt to use the intelligent tester. If the screen
displays a communication error message, a
problem exists in the vehicle or in the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the tool
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
DL
DL–11
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester with CAN VIM to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
BODY:
Item
Measurement Item / Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Unlock warning switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key cylinder
-
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CYT SW
Passenger side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is open
OFF: Passenger side door is closed
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Right or left rear door is open
OFF: Right and left rear doors are closed
-
P LOCK POS SW
Passenger side door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is lock is in
UNLOCK position
OFF: Passenger side door lock is in
LOCK position
-
Rr LOCK POS SW
Rear door lock position switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock is in UNLOCK
position
OFF: Rear door lock is in LOCK position
-
Ignition switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Key is in ON or START position
OFF: Key is in OFF or ACC position
-
Driver side door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Driver side door lock is in lock
position
-
Manual door lock switch LOCK signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Manual door lock switch is in LOCK
position
OFF: Manual door lock switch is in
neutral position
(Common to driver side and passenger
side mode)
-
Manual door lock switch UNLOCK signal
/ ON or OFF
ON: Manual door lock switch is in
UNLOCK position
OFF: Manual door lock switch is in
neutral position
(Common to driver side and passenger
side)
-
DOR KEY SW-LOCK
Key operation door lock switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Key operation door lock switch is in
lock position
OFF: Key operation door lock switch is in
neutral position
(Common to driver side and passenger
side mode)
-
P DOR KEY SW-UL
Key operation passenger door unlock
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger key operation door lock
switch is in unlock position
OFF: Passenger key operation door lock
switch is in neutral position
-
KEY UNLK WRN SW
IG SW
D LOCK POS SW
D/L SW-LOCK
D/L SW-UNLOCK
DL
DL–12
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Key operation driver door unlock switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver key operation door lock
switch is in unlock position
OFF: Driver key operation door lock
switch is in neutral position
-
Key operation driver door 2-step unlock
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: All doors are unlocked when driver
side door key cylinder is turned to unlock
twice (2-step unlocking function)
OFF: Only driver side door is unlocked
when driver side door key cylinder is
turned to unlock once
-
Park/neutral position switch signal / ON
or OFF
ON: Ignition switch ON, vehicle speed 0
km/h and shift to any position except P
position → Shift to P position → all doors
unlock
OFF: Ignition switch ON, vehicle speed 0
km/h and shift to any position except P
position
-
AUTO LOCK/SHIFT
Shift lever in any position other than P
position signal / ON or OFF
ON: All doors lock when shift lever is
shifted to any position other P from P
position
OFF: No door locks when shift lever is
shifted to any position other than P from
P position
-
OPEN DOOR WARN
Door courtesy switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Each door is open
OFF: All doors are closed
-
AUTO LOCK DELAY
Door courtesy switch signal / 30s or 60s
30s: Door auto locking time is 30 sec.
60s: Door auto locking time is 60 sec.
-
D DOR KEY SW-UL
UNLK/KEY TWICE
UNLOCK/PARK
BACK DOOR:
Item
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY SW (UNLK)
Back door key lock and unlock switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Back door lock key cylinder is turned
to unlock
OFF: Key is in back door lock key
cylinder (original position)
-
KEY SW (LOCK)
Back door key lock and unlock switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Back door lock key cylinder is turned
to unlock
OFF: Key is in back door lock key
cylinder (original position)
-
HALF LATCH SW
Back door half latch switch signal /ON or
OFF
ON: Back door is open
OFF: Back door is closed
-
FULL LATCH SW
Back door full latch switch (courtesy SW)
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Back door is closed
OFF: Back door is open
-
DOOR HANDLE SW
Back door opener switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Back door opener is pushed
OFF: Back door opener is not pushed
-
Back door position switch signal /
UNLOCK or LOCK
UNLOCK: Back door is unlock
LOCK: Back door is lock
-
LOCK STATUS
Measurement Item / Display (Range)
2.
DL
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate
without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
a first step of troubleshooting is one of the methods to
shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
DL–13
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) According to the display on the tester, perform the
ACTIVE TEST.
BODY:
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Turn open door warning light
ON / OFF (All doors are closed)
-
DOOR LOCK
Drive door lock motor at all doors LOCK /
OFF
-
DOOR LOCK
Drive door lock motor at all doors UNLOCK /
OFF
-
OPN DOR WRN LGT
DL
DL–44
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
The wireless door lock control data list can be displayed
while the intelligent tester is connected to the DLC3 with
the ignition switch in the ON position. Follow the prompts
on the tester screen to access the DATA LIST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
BODY:
Item (Display)
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Measurement Item / Display (Range)
Unlock warning switch / ON or OFF
2.
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON: Ignition key is inserted
OFF: Ignition key is not inserted
-
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows components such as the relay, VSV and actuator
to operate without removing parts. Performing the
ACTIVE TEST as the first step in troubleshooting is one
way to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) According to the display on the tester, preform the
ACTIVE TEST.
HINT:
The ignition switch must be turned to the ON
position to proceed with the ACTIVE TEST using
the intelligent tester.
BODY:
Item (Display)
DL
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
BUZZ CONT SOUND
Turns wireless door lock buzzer ON /OFF
-
BUZZ RESP SOUND
Turns wireless door lock buzzer ON / OFF
-
DL–45
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
• If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check,
inspect the circuit listed for that code. For details of the
code, refer to the "See page" in the DTC chart.
• Inspect the fuse and relay before investigating the
suspected areas shown in the table below.
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Suspected Area
See page
B1242
Wireless Door Lock Tuner Circuit
Malfunction
1. Wire harness
2. Door control receiver
3. Instrument panel J/B (Multiplex
network body ECU)
DL-42
DL
DL–46
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
B1242
Wireless Door Lock Tuner Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a ground short is detected in terminal RDA or PRG.
DTC No.
B1242
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Ground short in terminal RDA or PRG
Door control receiver
Wire Harness
Instrument panel J/B assembly (Body ECU)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
D7
Door Control Receiver
Body ECU
PRG
RDA
3
G-O
A13
IE1
G-O
3
B5
PRG
2
L-R
A12
IE1
L-R
4
B5
RDA
B062222E01
DL
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
(a) Check that the wireless system when a new or normal
door control receiver is installed.
(b) Check that no DTC is output.
DL–47
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D7 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the B5 J/B connector.
(c) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
D7 Door Control Receiver
B5
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
RDA (D7-2) - RDA (B5-4)
Below 1 Ω
PRG (D7-3) - PRG (B5-3)
Below 1 Ω
(d) Check the continuity between the D7 receiver connector
B5 J/B connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
RDA (D7-2) or RDA (B5-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
PRG (D7-3) or PRG (B5-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B062225E02
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
DL–1
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
DOOR
LOCK
PARTS LOCATION
UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
FRONT COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH RH
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
- BODY ECU
REAR DOOR LOCK RH
REAR
COURTESY
LIGHT
SWITCH RH
POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR
OPENER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
- DOOR CONTROL
SWITCH
MULTIPLEX NETWORK
BACK DOOR ECU
FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
FRONT COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH LH
- BACK DOOR ECU
DL
REAR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
REAR DOOR LOCK LH
W/ MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
- BACK DOOR LOCK
B120209E02
DL–2
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the power door lock
control system.
• The intelligent tester should be used in steps 3 and 5.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Interview the customer to confirm the trouble (See page
IN-30).
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
DL
A
Fault is listed on problem symptoms
table
B
B
After repair, go to step 7
A
5
Proceed to
Fault is not listed on problem
symptoms table
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–3
(See page DL-6)
(b) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
(See page DL-9)
NEXT
6
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
DL
DL–48
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Only Wireless Control Function is Inoperative
DESCRIPTION
The door control receiver receives a signal from the transmitter and sends this signal to the body ECU.
Then, the body ECU controls operation of the door locks except the back door lock in response to this
signal, while the body ECU sends a signal to the back door ECU at the same time. Receiving this signal,
the back door ECU controls operation of the back door lock. Also, the back door ECU causes the back
window to open, receiving a signal from the transmitter via the body ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
D7
Door Control Receiver
PRG
1
W-B
A
A J40
J40
J/C
A J41
E
+B
C
G-Y
J15
2
J15
J/C
W-B
W-B
A
BO
3
G-O
A13
IE1
G-O
3
B5 PRG
2
L-R
A12
IE1
L-R
4
B5 RDA
5
R
To
Battery
K3
Un-lock Warning
Switch Assembly
1
W-B
RDA
Body ECU
J/C
B
E
G-Y
J14
J18
J/C
14
A
G-Y
B6 KSW
J19
J5
J/C
A
W-B
A
BL
1G
B062223E01
DL
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS
(a) Check the wireless door lock control system (See page
DL-29).
OK
END
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–49
NG
2
CHECK TRANSMITTER BATTERY
(a) After replacing the transmitter battery with a new or
normal one and then operating the transmitter LOCK/
UNLOCK in the standard operation, check that the doors
can lock and unlock even after operating it more than 3
times.
NOTICE:
Standard operation, herein, means operation by
pressing the transmission switch for 1 second,
directing the transmitter to the vehicle in a location
that is 100 cm (39.37 in.) away from the driver side
door outside handle in the right direction.
NG
Go to step 7
OK
REPLACE TRANSMITTER BATTERY
3
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
(a) Check if the wireless door lock buzzer sounds.
Result
Condition
Proceed To
Buzzer sounds
A
Buzzer does not sound
Go to "No Answer-Back (Hazard Warning Light and Wireless
Door Lock Buzzer)" (See page DL-52)
A
4
SWITCH TO SELF DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Switch to self-diagnostic mode using the intelligent
tester.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the intelligent
tester main switch on.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
(b) Switch to self-diagnostic mode by performing the
following (Manual operation):
(1) Put the vehicle under the initial condition (See page
DL-29). (Procedure "A")
(2) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder and
remove it. (Procedure "B")
DL
DL–50
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Buzzer Output:
T1: 0.13 seconds
T2: 0.5 seconds
ON
(3) Within 5 seconds after the key is removed, insert
the key into the ignition key cylinder again.
(Procedure "C")
(4) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn it back OFF.
(Procedure "D")
(5) Within 30 seconds of turning the ignition switch OFF
again, perform the following 9 times: Turn the
ignition switch ON and turn it back to OFF.
(Procedure "E")
HINT:
• Turning the ignition switch to the ON position
after Procedure "E" has been completed will end
the self-diagnostic mode.
• Do not lock or unlock doors during the selfdiagnostic mode.
NOTICE:
If the self-diagnostic mode cannot be achieved,
the system will return to normal mode.
(c) Check that the system has switched to self-diagnostic
mode by checking the sound of the wireless door lock
buzzer.
OK:
The sound pattern of the wireless door lock buzzer
should be the same as the patterns shown in the
timing chart on the illustration.
NG
Go to step 9
OFF
T1
T2
B110075E01
OK
5
CHECK BY SELF DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Check the diagnostic outputs when the door control
transmitter switch is held down. The diagnostic outputs
can be checked by the sound of the wireless door lock
buzzer.
DL
DL–51
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Buzzer Output:
Normal Wave (LOCK Switch):
T1
Unmatched Recognition Code:
T3
ON
Wave is being received
OFF
ON
Normal Wave (UNLOCK Switch):
OFF
T1
T2
T1
T3
ON
OFF
No Diagnostic Output:
Normal Wave (PANIC Switch or BACK WINDOW Switch):
OFF
T3
T3
ON
T1: 0.13 seconds
OFF
T2: 0.25 seconds
T3: 0.5 seconds
B110076E16
Result
Condition
Proceed To
Unmatched recognition code is output
A
Normal waves patterns from the wireless door lock buzzer are
output for LOCK, UNLOCK, PANIC and BACK WINDOW
B
No diagnostic outputs are recorded
C
B
C
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
Go to step 7
A
6
DL
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE
(a) Check that the system can switch to the rewrite mode or
add mode and whether a recognition code can be
registered.
DL–52
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OK:
The system can switch to the rewrite mode or add
mode, and a recognition code can be registered.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
END
7
CHECK RESPONSE OF DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
(a) When a new or normal door control transmitter switch for
the same type vehicle is held down, check that a
diagnosis of unmatching recognition code is output.
OK:
Unmatched recognition code is output.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
8
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
(a) Replace door control receiver with normal one.
NG
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
9
CONFIRM SELF DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Confirm input method for self-diagnostic mode.
Result
Condition
DL
Proceed To
Method for changing system self-diagnostic mode works
A
Method for changing system self-diagnostic mode does not work
B
B
A
Go to step 4
DL–53
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
10
INSPECT UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the unlock warning switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Unlock Warning Switch:
Free
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch pressed (Key
set)
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Switch free (Key
removed)
10 kΩ or higher
Pressed
NG
REPLACE UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
2 1
4 3
B110108E08
OK
11
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY ECU - UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the body ECU (B6) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
K3 Un-lock Warning Switch
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B6-14 (KSW) - K3-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
B6-14 (KSW) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩor higher
K3-2 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
B6
Body ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B062226E03
OK
DL
DL–54
12
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the D7 door control receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D7-5 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
D7 Door Control Receiver
B059092E10
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
13
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (E TERMINAL)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D7-1 (E) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
D7 Door Control Receiver
B059092E10
OK
14
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
(a) Reconnect D7 receiver connector, and check the voltage
according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard voltage
Door Control Receiver
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
RDA (D7-2) - Body
ground
Ignition switch OFF, no
key in ignition key
cylinder, all doors
closed and each
transmitter switch OFF
→ ON
Below 1 V → Approx. 6
to 7 V → Below 1 V
B051174E03
NOTICE:
Check the output voltage with the bar graph display.
DL
OK
NG
Go to step 16
DL–55
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
15
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY ECU - DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the receiver (D7) connector and body ECU
(B5) connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
D7 Door Control Receiver
B5
Body ECU
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D7-2 (RDA) - B5 -4
(RDA)
Always
Below 1 Ω
D7-2 (RDA) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩor higher
B5- 4 (RDA) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩor higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B062225E03
OK
16
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
(a) Replace the door control receiver with normal one.
OK:
The system returns to normal operation.
NG
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
DL
DL–56
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
No Answer-Back (Hazard Warning Light and Wireless Door Lock
Buzzer)
DESCRIPTION
If there is no answer-back of the hazard warning lights and wireless door lock buzzer while the wireless
control function is operating normally, the hazard light signal and the wireless door lock buzzer signal
output from the body ECU may be malfunctioning.
NOTICE:
Confirm that the answer-back function has been switched on as a result of customization before
starting troubleshooting.
DL
DL–57
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
with Daytime Running Light
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
W3
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
2
Body ECU
10
1B
9
Y-B
6
1B
7
14
1J
8
1
D2
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
10
HAZ
P-B
W
To
Hazard Warning
Signal Switch
W
without Daytime Running Light
Body ECU
P-B
10
1B
9
Y-B
6
1B
7
8
1
8
10
IF1
W
14
1J
To
Hazard Warning
Signal Switch
W
15
1J
W
HAZ
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
T9
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
EHW
BZR2
15
1J
W3
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
2
BZR
BZR
BZR2
HAZ
DL
B134205E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
DL–58
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
When using intelligent tester:
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS
(a) Check that the wireless door lock functions operate
when the transmitter is used (See page DL-29).
Result
Condition
Proceed To
Wireless door lock functions operate normally but hazard
warning light answer-back does not occur
A
Wireless door lock functions operate normally but wireless door
lock buzzer answer-back does not occur
B
Wireless door lock functions do not operate
Go to "Only Wireless Control Function is Inoperative" (See page
DL-44)
B
Go to step 4
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (HAZARD WARNING LIGHT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the intelligent tester.
BODY:
Item (Display)
HAZARD
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Turns the turn signal flasher relay ON / OFF
Observe headlight and rear combination light
for correct operation
(d) Check that "ON" and "OFF" of the hazard warning lights
on the headlight and rear combination light turn on and
off when the intelligent tester is used.
OK:
The hazard warning lights turn on or off in
accordance with commands of the intelligent
tester.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
3
CHECK HAZARD WARNING LIGHTS
(a) Check that the hazard warning lights flash continuously
when the hazard warning light switch is pressed.
OK:
Hazard warning lights flash continuously.
NG
INSPECT LIGHTING SYSTEM
DL–59
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
4
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the intelligent tester.
BODY:
Item (Display)
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
BUZZ CONT SOUND
Turns wireless door lock buzzer ON / OFF
Buzzer can be heard
BUZZ RESP SOUND
Turns wireless door lock buzzer ON / OFF
Buzzer can be heard
(d) Check that the buzzer sounds/stops when turning the
wireless door lock buzzer on/off by using the intelligent
tester.
Result
Condition
Proceed To
Buzzer sounds/stops
A
Buzzer does not sound or sounds constantly
B
B
Go to step 5
A
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
5
INSPECT WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
(a) Disconnect the wireless door lock buzzer connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
HINT:
The buzzer circuit is built into the ECU, not into the
buzzer itself. When battery voltage is applied directly to
the buzzer, the buzzer does not sound.
Resistance
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer:
2
1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
Approx. 1 kΩ
NG
B110079E04
OK
REPLACE WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
DL
DL–60
6
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER - INSTRUMENT
PANEL J/B)
(a) Disconnect the buzzer connector (W3) and J/B (1B)
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
W3
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
W3-1 - 1B-10 (BZR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
W3-2 - 1B - 6 (BZR2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
1B
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
B062227E02
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
When not using intelligent tester:
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS
(a) Check that the wireless door lock functions operate
when the transmitter is used (See page DL-29).
Result
Condition
Proceed To
Wireless door lock functions operate normally but hazard
warning light answer-back does not occur
A
Wireless door lock functions operate normally but wireless door
lock buzzer answer-back does not occur
B
Wireless door lock functions do not operate
DL
Go to "Only Wireless Control Function is Inoperative" (See page
DL-44)
B
A
Go to step 3
DL–61
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2
CHECK HAZARD WARNING LIGHTS
(a) Check that the hazard warning lights flash continuously
when the hazard warning light switch is pressed.
OK:
Hazard warning lights flash continuously.
NG
INSPECT LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
3
INSPECT WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
(a) Disconnect the wireless door lock buzzer connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
HINT:
The buzzer circuit is built into the ECU, not into the
buzzer itself. When battery voltage is applied directly to
the buzzer, the buzzer does not sound.
Resistance
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer:
2
1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Always
Approx. 1 kΩ
NG
REPLACE WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
B110079E04
OK
DL
DL–62
4
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (WIRELESS BUZZER - INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B)
(a) Disconnect the buzzer (W3) connector and J/B (1B)
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
W3
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
W3-1 - 1B-10 (BZR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
W3-2 - 1B - 6 (BZR2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
1B
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
B062227E02
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
DL–62
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
DL
REMOVE CHECK FUNCTION
(a) Check that the key reminder warning buzzer
sounds.
(1) With the driver side door closed, insert the key
into the ignition key cylinder and then turn the
key to LOCK or ACC.
(2) Check that the buzzer sounds intermittently if
the driver side door is opened.
(b) Check that the key reminder warning buzzer stops.
(1) Check that the buzzer stops sounding if any of
the following operations is performed while the
buzzer is sounding:
• Close the driver side door (front door
courtesy light switch is off).
• Turn the ignition switch ON.
• Pull out the key from the ignition key cylinder.
DL–63
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM:
Symptom
Key reminder buzzer does not sound
Suspected Area
See page
1. Unlock warning switch assembly
DL-66
2. Front door courtesy light switch circuit (Driver side)
DL-66
3. Combination meter assembly
DL-66
4. Instrument panel junction block assembly (Body ECU)
-
5. Wire harness
-
DL
DL–64
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
DL
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B ASSEMBLY (BODY
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector and 1F, 1E, 1B,
1L and 1H J/B connectors.
DL–65
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
Vehicle Rear Side
Right Side
Vehicle Front Side
1H
B6
1F
B5
1E
1L
1B
Body ECU
1F
1E
B5
Body ECU
1H
1L
B6
1B
DL
B064139E01
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance according to
the value(s) in the table below.
Symbols
(Terminal No.)
BECU (1F-12) - Body ground
Wiring Color
W-R - Body ground
Condition
Always
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
DL–66
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
Symbols
(Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
BECU (1B-4) - Body ground
W-R - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
BECU (1L-4) - Body ground
W-R - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
BDR1 (1E-9) - Body ground
G-W - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
GND1 (1H-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 (1H-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
G-Y - Body ground
No key in ignition key cylinder →
Key inserted
KSW (B6-14) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
HINT:
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the B6 connectors.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
DL
Symbols
(Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
DCTY (B5-23) - Body ground
R-B - Body ground
Driver door
CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 → 0 V
DL–67
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
Key reminder warning system data can be read through
the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When
the system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester to check for malfunctions and perform
repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle's ECU uses ISO 9141-2 for
communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2
format.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 1516
DLC3
F040034E03
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
54 to 67 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
3 kΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
3 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the display shows a communication error
message after connecting the intelligent tester to
the DLC3 and turning the ignition switch to the ON
position, there is a problem with either the vehicle or
the intelligent tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester itself. Consult
the Service Department listed in the tester's
operator's manual.
DL
DL–68
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester with CAN VIM to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST.
BODY (Body ECU):
Tester Display
KEY UNLK WRN SW
D DOR CTY SW
DL
Measurement Item/Range
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Unlock warning switch signal
/ON or OFF
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key
cylinder
-
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal
/ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–69
Key Reminder Buzzer does not Sound
DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is OFF, the key is in the ignition key cylinder, and the driver side door is opened,
the body ECU operates the combination meter to cause the buzzer to sound.
DL
DL–70
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel Junction Block Assembly
Body ECU
D12
Door Courtesy Light Switch (Driver Side)
J/C
1
R-B
F
J18
H
J19
R-B
23
B5 DCTY
E
J18
A
J19
G-Y
14
B6 KSW
K3
Un-lock Warning Switch
Assembly
J/C
W-B
1
W-B
C
G-Y
J15
2
B
J14
A
J15
A
J15
G-Y
W-B
A
J5
J/C
IG
Combination Meter
19
C9
V-G
15
B6 KSWO
8
C10
W-L
11
B6 DCY2
Buzzer
Meter ECU
DL
F044179E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
DL–71
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
When using intelligent tester:
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item "D DOR CTY SW" in the DATA LIST and
read its value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Standard:
ON:
Driver side door is open
OFF:
Driver side door is closed
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
INSPECT COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH (DRIVER SIDE)
Courtesy
Light Switch
(a) Remove the courtesy light switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Free
Pushed
Terminal No.
1 - Body ground
B058556E24
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Switch Free
Below 1 Ω
Switch Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
OK
DL
DL–72
3
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY ECU - COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the D12 door courtesy light switch (driver
side) and B5 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B5
Body ECU
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
DCTY (B5-23) - (D12-1)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
D12 Front Door Courtesy Light Switch
(Driver Side)
1
B064136E01
OK
4
CHECK BUZZER (COMBINATION METER)
(a) Check buzzer (combination meter). (See page ME-4)
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
OK
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (KEY UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item "KEY UNLK WRN SW" in the DATA LIST
and read its value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Standard:
ON:
The key is in the ignition key cylinder
OFF:
No key is in the ignition key cylinder
DL
OK
NG
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL–73
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
6
INSPECT UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Not Pushed
(a) Remove the un-lock warning switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Pin
Pushed
B062710E01
NG
Terminal No.
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Free
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY ECU - UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 warning switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B6
Body ECU
NG
K3
Un-lock Warning Switch Assembly
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
KSW (B6-14) - (K3-2)
Below 1 Ω
K3-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B064670E01
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
When not using intelligent tester:
1
CHECK COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
(a) Put the dome light assembly No. 2 switch in the door
position and open the driver side door. Then check that
the courtesy light switch comes on.
DL–74
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
OK
Go to step 3
NG
2
INSPECT COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
(a) Remove the courtesy light switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Free
Pushed
Terminal No.
1 - Body ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Free
Below 1 Ω
Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
Body ground
B058556E21
NG
REPLACE COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY ECU - COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the D12 door courtesy light switch (driver
side) and B5 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B5
Body ECU
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
DCTY (B5-23) - (D12-1)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
D12 Front Door Courtesy Light Switch
(Driver Side)
1
B064136E01
DL
OK
4
CHECK BUZZER (COMBINATION METER)
(a) Check buzzer (combination meter). (See page ME-4)
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
DL–75
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
OK
5
INSPECT UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Not Pushed
(a) Remove the un-lock warning switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Pin
Terminal No.
Pushed
1-2
B062710E01
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Free
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
OK
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BODY ECU - UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the K3 warning switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) table
below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B6
Body ECU
NG
K3
Un-lock Warning Switch Assembly
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
KSW (B6-14) - (K3-2)
Below 1 Ω
K3-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B064670E01
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
DL–14
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
All Doors LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate Via Master
Switch, Driver Side Door Key Cylinder
DESCRIPTION
The body ECU receives a switch signal from the master switch and the driver side door key cylinder, and
then drives the door lock motor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side J/B Assembly
D17
Power Window Regulator Master
Switch Assembly (Door Lock Switch)
L
1
5
E
UL
8
5
1K
1
1K
19
15
L1
UL1
D18
Door Lock Control Switch Assembly
(Passenger Side)
Body ECU
UNLOCK 5
6
LOCK
D16
Front Door w/ Motor Lock Assembly LH
L
UL
7
DL
E
UL
LSSR
L
3
1K
20
L2
9
10
12
B4
UL3
1
10
B4
ACTD
8
21
B4
LSWD
4
30
B4
LSWP
B134220E01
DL–15
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
D19
Front Door w/ Motor
Lock Assembly RH
LSSR
8
E
UL
L
7
1
4
9
1L
18
1L
23
24
ACT+
ACT-
6
1L
D20
Rear Door w/ Motor
Lock Assembly LH
LSSR
9
E
UL
L
6
1
4
16
1L
5
LSR
23
1L
11
1L
D21
Rear Door w/ Motor
Lock Assembly RH
LSSR
9
E
UL
L
6
1
4
15
1K
22
1L
10
1L
DL
B134221E01
DL–16
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Select the active test, and then check that the power
door lock operates.
HINT:
During the active test, the intelligent tester sends signal
to the body ECU to drive all the power door lock motor. If
the all power door lock operates, the power door lock
motor itself and the wire harness between the power
door lock motor and body ECU are considered normal.
BODY:
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DOOR LOCK
Drive door lock motor at all doors LOCK/OFF
-
DOOR LOCK
Drive door lock motor at all doors UNLOCK/
OFF
-
NG
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
OK
2
CHECK MASTER SWITCH OR KEY CYLINDER
(a) Check master switch or key cylinder operation.
(1) When manual door lock/unlock operation via the
master switch can not be performed, proceed to A.
(2) When manual door lock/unlock operation via the
door lock control switch (passenger side) can not be
performed, proceed to B.
(3) When manual door lock/unlock operation
interlocked with the driver side door lock key
cylinder can not be performed, proceed to C.
A
DL
B
Go to step 4
C
Go to step 5
DL–17
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
3
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the master switch.
(b) Inspect the door lock control switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Unlock
Lock
Door Lock Control Switch
Terminal No.
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
1-5
Lock
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1-8
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B059539E21
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
4
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Passenger
Side Switch
(a) Passenger side switch:
Inspect the door lock control switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Lock
Unlock
Terminal No.
Door Lock Position
3-6
Lock
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
OK
No Pin
(1 and 2)
No Pin (4)
B134223E01
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–18
5
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply battery voltage and inspect operation of the door
lock motor.
Standard
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
Unlock
Lock
B056798E02
Lock
(b) Inspect the door lock and unlock switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Unlock
Terminal No.
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
7-9
Lock
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
-
7 - 10
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
(c) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
7-8
OK
DL
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
Lock
10 kΩ or higher
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B056797E02
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
DL–26
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
DOOR
LOCK
PARTS LOCATION
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
DL
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
B120214E02
DL–27
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
UN-LOCK WARNING
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
FRONT COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH RH
REAR DOOR LOCK RH
INSTRUMENT PANEL
J/B ASSEMBLY
REAR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH RH
- BODY ECU
DOOR
CONTROL
RECEIVER
POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
BACK WINDOW
REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
- DOOR CONTROL
SWITCH
FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
W/ MOTOR BACK DOOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY
FRONT COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH LH
REAR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
REAR DOOR LOCK LH
MULTIPLEX NETWORK BACK DOOR ECU
- BACK DOOR ECU
DL
B120215E02
DL–19
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Key Lock-in Prevention Function does not Work Properly (Manual
Operation and Operation Interlocked with Key are Active)
DESCRIPTION
The un-lock warning switch turns ON when the key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder. The courtesy
light switch turns ON when the driver side door is opened. These 2 switches are monitored by the body
ECU. In order to prevent the key from being locked in, the body ECU controls door locking operation
according to conditions of these switches, so the doors are not locked.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side J/B Assembly
D12
Courtesy Light Switch Assembly
1
23
B5
K3
Un-lock Warning Switch Assembly
Body ECU
14
B6
B134222E01
DL
DL–20
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check that the un-lock
warning switch signal is output when the switch is
operated.
BODY:
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Key un-lock warning SW
signal/ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: Key is not in ignition key cylinder
OK
-
Go to step 4
NG
2
INSPECT UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Free
(a) Remove the un-lock warning switch.
(b) Inspect the un-lock warning switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Pin
Terminal No.
1-2
Pushed
NG
B062710E02
OK
DL
Condition
Specified Condition
Free
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
DL–21
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH - BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the K3 un-lock warning switch and B12 body
ECU connectors.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the unlock warning switch (K3) and body ECU (B6) connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
K3
Unlock Warning Switch
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
(K3-2) - KSW (B6-14)
Below 1 Ω
(K3-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
B6
Body ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B065425E01
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check that the driver door
courtesy switch signal is output when the switch is
operated.
BODY:
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
D DOR CTY SW
Driver door courtesy SW
signal / ON or OFF
Normal Condition
ON: Driver door is open
OFF: Driver door is closed
OK
Diagnostic Note
-
REPLACE COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
NG
DL
DL–22
5
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
(a) Remove the courtesy light switch.
(b) Inspect the courtesy light switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Free
Pushed
Terminal No.
1 - Body ground
Body ground
NG
B058556E21
Condition
Specified Condition
Free
Below 1 Ω
Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH - BODY ECU)
Wire Harness Side
D12
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch
(a) Disconnect the courtesy light switch and body ECU
connectors.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
courtesy light switch (D12) and body ECU (B5)
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
1
NG
B5
Body ECU
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
(D12-1) - DCTY (B5-23)
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B065420E02
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–59
KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
DOOR
LOCK
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METAR
- KEY REMINDER BUZZER
INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
- BODY ECU
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH
DL
B120213E02
DL–60
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the key reminder
warning system.
• The intelligent tester should be used in steps 5.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Interview the customer to confirm the trouble (See page
ED-3).
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed on problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed on problem symptoms table
B
B
After repair, go to step 6
A
4
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU
(See page DL-62)
(b) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
(See page DL-65)
NEXT
5
DL
NEXT
REPAIR OR REPLACE
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
6
DL–61
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
DL
DL–23
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Only Back Door cannot be Opened
DESCRIPTION
The signal for manual unlocking operation on driver side door and the signal for unlocking operation
interlocked with the driver side door lock key cylinder are sent to the back door ECU from the body ECU
using the MPX line. Also, the signal of the back door opener switch is directly sent to the back door ECU.
In response to these signals, the back door ECU controls the back door lock.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
V-W
10
B9 HSW+
LG-R
22
B9 HSW-
B10
Back Door Opener Switch Assembly
2
1
B7
w/ Motor Back Door Lock Assembly
(Back Door Lock)
5
R-G
6
B9 HALF
6
G-Y
7
B9 FULL
4
BR-W
8
B9 POS
1
L-B
15
B9 ACT+
2
L-R
14
B9 ACT-
3
B-R
21
B9 LSE
DL
B064455E01
DL–24
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Check the data list of back door opener switch.
BODY:
Item
Measurement Item/ Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
DOOR HANDLE SW
Back door opener SW signal / ON
or OFF
ON: Back door opener is pushed
OFF: Back door opener is not
pushed
-
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
INSPECT BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the back door opener switch.
(b) Inspect the back door opener switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
1-2
Free
OK
DL
NG
Pushed
B062727E01
Condition
Specified Condition
Free
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
DL–25
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH - BACK BODY)
(a) Disconnect the B10 back door opener switch and B9
back door ECU connectors.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the back
door opener switch (B10) and back door ECU (B9)
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open) :
Wire Harness Side
B10
Back Door Opener Switch
Symbols (Terminal No.)
NG
B9
Back Door ECU
Specified Condition
(B10-1) - HSW- (B9-22)
Below 1 Ω
(B10-2) - HSW+ (B9-10)
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B065426E01
OK
4
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Select the active test, and then check that the power
door lock operates.
HINT:
During the active test, the intelligent tester sends signal
to the body ECU to drive the all power door lock motor. If
the all power door lock operates, the power door lock
motor itself and the wire harness between the power
door lock motor and body ECU are considered normal.
BODY:
Item
Test Details
DOOR LOCK
Drive the door lock motor at all doors LOCK/
OFF
-
DOOR LOCK
Drive the door lock motor at all doors
UNLOCK/ OFF
-
OK
NG
Diagnostic Note
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
DL–26
5
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT W/MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Check operation of the door lock.
(1) Using a screwdriver, push the latch in order to put
the back door lock in the locked condition (full-latch
position).
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and the
negative (-) lead to terminal 2. Then, check
operation of the latch.
Standard:
The latch turns to the open-latch position
(3) Inspect motor operation when battery voltage is
applied to the terminals.
Standard
Full-latch
Open-latch
B065423E02
DL
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Clockwise (Motor in normal rotation)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Counterclockwise (Motor in reverse
rotation)
DL–27
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Check the back door courtesy switch continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
courtesy switch.
Standard resistance
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Half-latch position
4-5
Below 1 Ω
Full-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-5
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Check the back door latch switch continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
latch switch.
Standard resistance
Open-latch
Half-latch
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-6
Below 1 Ω
Half-latch position,
Full-latch position
4-6
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Check the position switch continuity.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to connector
terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to connector
terminal 2.
Standard resistance
Full-latch
Over-latch
B062719E01
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Any position other than
motor stop position
(Motor in operation)
3-4
Below 1 Ω
Motor stop position
(Gear in original
position)
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE W/MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
DL
DOOR LOCK – TRANSMITTER BATTERY
DL–73
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the transmitter case.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly pry out the case.
(b) Remove the battery (lithium battery).
NOTICE:
• Do not push the terminals with your finger.
• Prying up the battery (lithium battery) to
forcibly remove it will cause deformation of
the terminals.
• Do not touch the battery with wet hands.
Water may cause unexpected rust.
• Do not touch or move any components inside
the transmitter, or it may interfere with the
proper operation.
B062228
2.
B062229E01
REMOVE TRANSMITTER BATTERY
NOTICE:
Special caution should be taken for handling each
component as they are precision electronic
components.
INSTALL TRANSMITTER BATTERY
(a) Install a new battery (lithium battery) with the
positive (+) side up, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
• Be sure that the positive side and the
negative side of the transmitter battery are
faced correctly.
• Be careful not to bend the electrode of the
transmitter battery insertion.
• Be careful that no dust or oil adheres to the
transmitter case.
(b) Install the case.
DL
DL–28
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
The wireless door lock control system troubleshooting
procedures are based on the premise that the power door
lock control system is operating normally. Check the power
door lock control system first before troubleshooting the
wireless door lock control system.
Use this procedure to troubleshoot the wireless door lock
control system.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Interview the customer to confirm the trouble (See page
IN-30).
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check for normal function of
the multiplex communication system.
(1) (ECU unconnected, communication line
malfunctioning) If no code is output, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU unconnected, communication line
malfunctioning) If any code is output, proceed to B.
B
Go To CAN COMMUNICATION SECTION
A
4
DTC CHECK
(a) Check for a DTC and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
(1) If the DTC does not reoccur, proceed to A.
(2) If the DTC reoccurs, proceed to B.
DL
B
A
Go To DTC chart
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
5
DL–29
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) If the fault is not listed in the problem symptoms table,
proceed to A.
(b) If the fault is listed in the problem symptoms table,
proceed to B.
B
Go to step 7
A
7
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING ACCORDING TO MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
(a) Terminals of ECU (See page DL-38)
(b) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST (See page DL-40)
NEXT
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
9
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
DL
DL–74
DOOR LOCK – DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
INSPECTION
1.
B062233E01
DL
INSPECT ELECTRICAL KEY TRANSMITTER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect operation of the transmitter.
(1) Remove the battery (lithium battery) from the
transmitter (See page DL-73).
(2) Install a new or normal battery (lithium battery).
(3) If a new or normal battery is not available,
connect 2 new 1.5 V batteries in a series.
Connect the positive (+) battery electrode to
the battery receptacle side terminal, and the
negative (-) battery electrode to the bottom
terminal, and apply a voltage of 3 V to the
transmitter.
(4) In a location that is approximately 1 m (3.28 ft.)
away from the driver side outside door handle,
point the key plate of the transmitter at the
vehicle and check operation of the transmitter
by pressing the transmission switches on the
transmitter body.
Standard:
The door lock can be operated via remote
control.
HINT:
• The minimum operational distance differs
depending on the operator, the way the
transmitter is held, and the location.
• Since the transmitter uses faint electric
waves, the operational distance might be
shortened if noise or a strong electric wave
occurs in the area where the frequency is
used.
(5) Install the battery (lithium battery).
(b) Inspect the battery capacity.
HINT:
• The capacity of the battery can be determined
only when the battery is installed in the
transmitter. For a lithium battery used in the
transmitter, a voltage of more than 2.5 V is
shown on the tester until the energy is
completely consumed without the battery
installed in the transmitter. Therefore, it is
necessary to measure the voltage with the
battery installed in the transmitter (a resistance of
1.2 kΩ is applied to the battery) to check the
amount of energy left in the battery.
• If the transmitter is faulty, the amount of energy
left in the battery might not be checked correctly.
(1) Remove the battery (lithium battery) from the
transmitter (See page DL-73).
DOOR LOCK – DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
DL–75
(2) Connect the lead to the negative (-) terminal of
the transmitter and install the battery.
Lead
B062236E02
B062232
(3) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to the
positive (+) side of the battery (lithium battery)
and the negative (-) tester probe to the lead
respectively.
(4) Press one of the transmission switches on the
transmitter for approximately 1 second.
(5) Press the same or another transmission switch
again and check the voltage.
Standard voltage:
2.2 V or higher
NOTICE:
• If the temperature of the battery is low,
the inspection cannot be done correctly.
If the outcome of the test is less than 2.2
V, conduct the test again after leaving the
battery in a place with a temperature of
18°C (64°F) for more than 30 minutes.
• The automatic power-off function causes
the battery voltage to be 2.5 V or more
(with no resistance applied to the battery)
when 0.8 seconds have passed after the
switch is pressed. Therefore, make sure
to read the voltage immediately after the
switch is pressed.
(6) Disconnect the lead.
(7) Set the battery (lithium battery) in the
transmitter.
DL
DL–30
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
2.
DL
FUNCTIONS AND OPERATING CONDITIONS
(a) Wireless door LOCK / UNLOCK function:
This function operates only when the following 3
condition are met.
(1) No key is inserted into the ignition key cylinder.
(2) All the doors are closed.
(3) The power door lock system and the back door
power window control system operate normally.
HINT:
• The UNLOCK, BACK WINDOW and PANIC
function operates even when a door is open.
• The UNLOCK, BACK WINDOW and PANIC
function operates even when the key is
inserted into the ignition key cylinder,
however the ignition switch must be in the
OFF position.
(b) The transmitter's operational area differs depending
on the situation.
(1) The operational area differs depending on the
operators and the ways the transmitter is held.
(2) In certain areas, the transmitter will only operate
partially, the operational area will be reduced
due to the vehicle body shape and the influence
of the surrounding environment.
(3) Since the transmitter uses faint electric waves,
strong electric waves or noise in the frequency
used may reduce the operational area or the
transmitter may not function.
(4) When the battery weakens, the operational area
is reduced or the transmitter may not function.
HINT:
If the door control transmitter has been left in a
place that is exposed to direct sunlight, such as
on the instrument panel, it may cause the battery
to weaken or cause other such problems.
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL
FUNCTIONS
HINT:
• The switches described below transmit signals and
are built into the door control transmitter.
• The transmitter's operational area must be taken into
account while checks are being made.
(a) Make sure the vehicle is in the initial condition
described below.
(1) The followings are the vehicle's initial condition.
• No key is in the ignition key cylinder
• All the doors closed
• The power door lock system and the back
door power window control system operate
normally.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–31
(b) Check the basic function.
(1) In the operational area, check that all the doors
lock when pressing the LOCK switch (However,
this will not happen when the key is in the
ignition key cylinder or any door is open).
(2) In the operational area, check that the only
driver's door unlocks when pressing the
UNLOCK switch and pressing the switch once
again within 3 seconds unlocks all the other
doors.
HINT:
The UNLOCK and BACK WINDOW operation is
possible even when any of the doors is open.
(3) In the operational area, check that the back
window opens when the BACK WINDOW switch
has been pressed for 0.8 seconds.
(c) Check the chattering prevention function.
(1) If a switch is pressed, check that the
corresponding operation occurs only once. If the
switch is held down, check that the
corresponding operation occurs only once and
does not repeatedly activate. Lastly, if a switch is
pressed at 1 second intervals, check that the
corresponding operation activates once for
every press of the switch.
(d) Check the automatic locking function.
(1) Check that if all of the doors are unlocked with
the UNLOCK switch and none of the doors are
opened or locked within approximately 30
seconds, the doors automatically relock.
(2) Check that if all of the doors are unlocked with
the UNLOCK switch and a door is opened or
locked within approximately 30 seconds, the
automatic locking function does not operate.
(e) Check the switch operation fail-safe function.
(1) Check that when the key is in the ignition
cylinder, the switches cannot lock or unlock
doors (unless the system is in the recognition
code registration mode.)
(f) Check the repeat function.
(1) If the lock switch is pressed while the movement
of the driver side door control knob is restricted,
check that, 1 second later, the repeat function
attempts to lock all of the doors again.
(g) Check the operation stop function when a door is
open or not completely close.
(1) If a door is open or not completely closed, check
that the doors cannot be locked by the LOCK
switch and buzzer sounds for 10 seconds.
DL
DL–32
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(h) Check the hazard warning lights flashing and
wireless door lock buzzer sounding function
(answer back).
(1) When the LOCK switch is pressed, check that
the hazard warning lights flash once and the
buzzer sounds once, simultaneously with locking
operation of all the doors.
(2) When the UNLOCK switch is pressed once,
check that the hazard warning lights flash twice,
the buzzer sounds twice, simultaneously with
the unlocking operation of the driver side door.
(3) When the UNLOCK switch is pressed again
within 3 seconds, check that the hazard warning
lights flash twice, the buzzer sounds twice,
simultaneously with the unlocking operation of
all the doors.
(4) When the BACK WINDOW switch is pressed for
0.8 seconds, check that the buzzer sounds
once, simultaneously with the opening operation
of the back window.
(i) Check the remote panic function.
(1) Check that the horns sounds, headlights and
taillights flash and the interior light remains on
for 60 seconds when the PANIC switch is
pressed, and that sounding and flashing stop
when either of the PANIC, LOCK, UNLOCK or
BACK WINDOW switch is pressed.
DL
DL–76
DOOR LOCK – DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
INSPECTION
Unlock
Lock
1.
Door Lock Control Switch
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the Value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
Switch Position
Specified Condition
1-5
Lock
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1-8
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
B059539E21
Passenger
Side Switch
2.
Lock
Unlock
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Passenger side switch:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
Switch Position
Specified Condition
3-6
Lock
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
No Pin
(1 and 2)
No Pin (4)
B134223E01
3.
INSPECT BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the back door opener switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
1-2
DL
Pushed
Free
B062727E01
Condition
Specified Condition
Free
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–33
REGISTRATION
HINT:
• Register the recognition code if the door control transmitter
or the door control receiver has been replaced.
• Add mode is used to register new recognition codes while
still retaining codes already registered. This mode is used
when a new transmitter is added. If the number of
registered codes exceeds 4, the previously registered
codes will be erased in order, starting from the oldest
registered code.
• Rewrite mode is used to erase all the previously registered
recognition codes in order to register all new recognition
codes. This mode is used when the transmitter or the door
control receiver is exchanged for a new one.
• Confirmation mode is used to confirm the number of
recognition codes already registered before another
recognition code is registered.
• All clear mode is used to erase all the registered codes
and disable the wireless door lock function. This mode is
used when the transmitter is lost.
• All the following registration procedures must be
performed in order.
1.
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE USING
INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Select Add mode or Rewrite mode and perform the
following operation:
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) Select the add or rewrite mode according to the
intelligent tester display.
(3) Press LOCK and UNLOCK on the transmitter
simultaneously for more than 1 second.
(Procedure "A")
(4) Press either of the switches on the door control
transmitter again for more than 1 second.
(Procedure "B")
HINT:
The Procedure "B" must be performed within 3
seconds after the first operation.
DL
DL–34
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(5) The body ECU automatically performs the
power door LOCK-UNLOCK operation after the
switch on the door control transmitter is turned
off, in order to indicate whether registration has
been completed correctly or not.
Response to Registration Completion
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Once:
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Twice:
Registration of recognition code has been completed.
Registration of recognition code has failed.
T1
T1
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
T1
T1: Approx. 1 second
B110067E03
DL
HINT:
• Complete the Procedure "A", "B" and
"Response to Registration Completion"
within 30 seconds.
• If the LOCK-UNLOCK operation is
performed twice, registration of the
recognition code has failed. Perform
registration procedures from the beginning
once again.
(6) If registration is continued, the next recognition
code must be registered in the door control
transmitter within 40 seconds.
HINT:
Up to 4 recognition codes can be registered.
(b) Completing the registration mode.
(1) The registration mode will cease when any of
the following occurs:
• The intelligent tester is used to order
completion.
• The intelligent tester is disconnected.
(c) Perform the following after registration is completed.
(1) Perform the wireless door lock control
operation check (See page DL-29).
HINT:
If the wireless door lock control does not
operate, perform the registration procedure
again.
(d) Select Confirmation mode and perform the following
operation:
(1) Number of registered code is shown.
(2) Registration procedures are completed.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
DL–35
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE MANUAL
OPERATION
(a) Ensure that the following conditions are met:
(1) No key is in the ignition key cylinder.
(2) Driver side door is opened (Other doors are
closed).
(3) Driver side door is unlocked.
(b) When the above conditions are met, perform the
following:
(1) Insert and remove the key from the ignition key
cylinder twice. (End in remove) (Procedure "A")
HINT:
Complete this step within 5 seconds.
(2) Close and open the driver side door twice. (End
in open) (Procedure "B")
(3) Insert and remove the key from the ignition key
cylinder. (Procedure "C")
(4) Close and open the driver side door twice. (End
in open) (Procedure "D")
(5) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder and
close all doors. (Procedure "E")
HINT:
Complete the Procedure "B" through "E" within
40 seconds.
(6) Turn the ignition switch from LOCK to ON and
back to LOCK at approximately 1 second
intervals according to the number of times
shown in the illustration. (Procedure "F")
Number of ON-LOCK Operations of the Ignition Switch
Add Mode:
Confirmation Mode:
ON-LOCK operation: 1 time
ON-LOCK operation: 3 times
T1
T1
ON
ON
LOCK
LOCK
Rewrite Mode:
T1
Prohibition Mode:
ON-LOCK operation: 2 times
T1
ON-LOCK operation: 5 times
T1
T1
ON
ON
LOCK
LOCK
T1
DL
T1: Approx. 1 second
B110068E06
DL–36
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
If the number of on ON-LOCK operations of the
ignition switch is 0, 4 or 6 or more, there will be
no response (power door lock and unlock
operation) to show which mode has been
selected.
(7) Remove the key from the ignition key cylinder.
(Procedure "G")
HINT:
Complete the Procedure "F" and "G" within 40
seconds.
(8) The body ECU automatically performs the
power door LOCK-UNLOCK operation within 3
seconds after the mode has been selected and
informs the technician of the selected mode
using the following response patterns.
Response to a Selected Mode (Power Door Lock Operation)
Add Mode:
Confirmation Mode:
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: 1 time
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: The number of registered codes (1 - 5 times)
1st time
T1
T2
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
T2
Rewrite Mode:
Prohibition Mode:
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: 2 times
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: 5 times
T1
T1
T1
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
2nd time
T1
T1: Approx. 1 second
T2: Approx. 2 seconds
B110069E02
DL
HINT:
• When the confirmation mode or all clear
mode has been selected, the registration
procedure will be completed.
• In the confirmation mode, when the LOCKUNLOCK operation is performed twice, the
number of registered recognition codes is 2.
• In the confirmation mode, when 0 codes are
registered, the LOCK-UNLOCK operation is
automatically performed 5 times.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–37
(c) Registration of the door control transmitter.
(1) If the add mode or rewrite mode has been
selected, press LOCK and UNLOCK on the
transmitter simultaneously for more than 1
second. (Procedure "H")
(2) Press either of the switches on the door control
transmitter for more than 1 second. (Procedure
"I")
HINT:
• The Procedure "I" must be performed within
3 seconds after the first operation.
• A recognition code must be registered in the
door control transmitter within 40 seconds
after a selected mode is responded to.
(3) The body ECU automatically performs the
power door LOCK-UNLOCK operation within 3
seconds after the switch on the door control
transmitter is turned off, in order to indicate
whether registration has been completed
correctly or not.
Response to Registration Completion
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Once:
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Twice:
Registration of recognition code has been completed.
Registration of recognition code has failed.
T1
T1
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
T1
T1: Approx. 1 second
B110067E03
HINT:
If the LOCK-UNLOCK operation is performed
twice, registration of the recognition code has
failed. Perform registration procedures from the
beginning once again.
(4) If registration is continued, the next recognition
code must be registered in the door control
transmitter within 40 seconds.
HINT:
Up to 4 recognition codes can be registered.
(d) Completing the registration mode.
(1) The registration mode will cease when any of
the following occurs:
• Any of the doors is opened.
• The key is inserted into the ignition key
cylinder.
DL
DL–38
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Perform the following after registration is completed.
(1) Perform the wireless door lock control
operation check (See page DL-29).
HINT:
If the wireless door lock control does not
operate, perform the registration procedure
again.
DL
DL–77
DOOR LOCK – FRONT DOOR LOCK
FRONT DOOR LOCK
INSPECTION
1.
Unlock
Lock
INSPECT FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply battery voltage and inspect operation of the
door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
B056798E02
Lock
Unlock
(b) Inspect the door lock and unlock switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
7-9
Lock
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
-
7 - 10
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door
lock assembly.
(c) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
7-8
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
Lock
10 kΩ or higher
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door
lock assembly.
B056797E02
DL
DL–78
DOOR LOCK – FRONT DOOR LOCK
2.
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Unlock
Lock
B059885E02
DL
INSPECT FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Apply battery voltage and inspect operation of the
door lock motor.
OK
DL–39
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM:
Symptom
Only wireless control function does not operate
(Prepare new or normal transmitter of the same type
vehicle)
No answer-back (Hazard warning light and wireless
door lock buzzer)
Suspected area
See page
1. Transmitter battery
DL-44
2. Door control transmitter
DL-44
3. Door control receiver
DL-44
4. Un-lock warning switch assembly
DL-44
5. Wire harness
-
6. Instrument panel J/B (Body ECU)
-
1. Wireless door lock buzzer
DL-52
2. Lighting system
LI-8
3. Wire harness
-
4. Instrument panel J/B (Body ECU)
-
DL
DL–40
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
Vehicle Rear Side
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (BODY ECU)
Vehicle Right Side
Vehicle Front Side
1H
B6
1E
B5
1J
1C
1D
1B
Body ECU
Body ECU
1E
1D
B6
1C
1B
B5
1H
1J
DL
B062230E01
(a) Disconnect the B6 J/B connector.
DL–41
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the 1B, 1C, 1E and 1H J/B connectors.
(c) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of
the wire harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring
Condition
Specified Condition
KSW (B6-14) - Body ground
G-Y - Body ground
No key in ignition key cylinder → Key inserted
BDR1 (1E-9) - Body ground
G-W - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
BECU (1B-4) - Body ground
W-R - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
SIG (1C-2) - Body ground
L-Y - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
ACC (1D-5) - Body ground
W-G - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
GND1 (1H-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 (1H-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(d) Reconnect the B6 J/B connector.
(e) Reconnect the 1B, 1C, 1D, 1E and 1H J/B
connectors.
(f) Check the voltage of each terminal of the
connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 V → 6 V → Below
1V
RDA (B5-4) - Body ground
L-R - Body ground
Ignition switch OFF, no key in ignition key cylinder, all
doors closed and transmitter switch OFF → ON
DCTY (B5-23) - Body ground
R-B - Body ground
Driver's door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
PCTY (B5-24) - Body ground
R-Y - Body ground
Passenger's door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
RLCY (B5-11) - Body ground
P-B - Body ground
Rear door LH CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
RRCY (B5-12) - Body ground
P-L - Body ground
Rear door RH CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
HAZ (1J-14) - Body ground
W - Body ground
BZR (1B-10) - Body ground
P-B - Y-B
Answer-back OFF → Answer-back ON
Pulse generation
Wireless buzzer OFF → ON
Pulse generation
If the result is not as specified, the J/B assembly
(body ECU) may have a malfunction.
DL
DL–79
DOOR LOCK – REAR DOOR LOCK
REAR DOOR LOCK
INSPECTION
1.
Lock
Unlock
INSPECT REAR DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Apply battery voltage and inspect operation of the
door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
If the operation is not as specified, replace the door
lock assembly.
(b) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
B056800E02
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
6-9
Lock
10 kΩor higher
6-9
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door
lock assembly.
2.
Unlock
INSPECT REAR DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Apply battery voltage and inspect operation of the
door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
(b) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Lock
B056799E02
Terminal No.
Door Lock Position
Specified Condition
6-9
Lock
10 kΩor higher
6-9
Unlock
Below 1 Ω
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door
lock assembly.
DL
DL–42
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
SG
1.
DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU stores trouble codes
when trouble occurs on the vehicle.
The diagnostic system allows for reading of the trouble
codes from the DLC3.
Use the intelligent tester to check and solve the problem.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The multiplex network body ECU uses ISO 9141-2
for communication protocol. The terminal
arrangement of the DLC3 complies with SAEJ1962
and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
BAT
A082779E04
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
(b) Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and
attempt to use the intelligent tester. If the screen
displays a communication error message, a
problem exists in the vehicle or in the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the tool
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
DL
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–43
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
DTC CHECK/CLEAR (USING INTELLIGENT TESTER:)
(a) DTC check
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Read the DTCs on the tester screen.
(b) DTC clear
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Clear the DTCs following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
DL
DL–80
DOOR LOCK – BACK DOOR LOCK
BACK DOOR LOCK
INSPECTION
1.
Fuel-latch
Open-latch
B065423E01
INSPECT W/MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Check operation of the door lock.
(1) Using a screwdriver, push the latch in order to
put the back door lock in the locked condition
(full-latch position).
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and
the negative (-) lead to terminal 2. Then, check
operation of the latch.
Standard:
The latch turns to the open-latch position
(3) Inspect motor operation when battery voltage is
applied to the terminals.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Clockwise (Motor in normal rotation)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Counterclockwise (Motor in reverse
rotation)
If the operation is not as specified, replace the
door lock assembly.
DL
DL–81
DOOR LOCK – BACK DOOR LOCK
(b) Check the back door courtesy switch continuity.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Half-latch position
4-5
Below 1 Ω
Full-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-5
10 kΩ or higher
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the
door lock assembly.
(c) Check the back door latch switch continuity.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Open-latch
Half-latch
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-6
Below 1 Ω
Half-latch position,
Full-latch position
4-6
10 kΩ or higher
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the
door lock assembly.
(d) Check the position switch continuity.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to
connector terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead
to connector terminal 2.
Standard resistance
Full-latch
Over-latch
B062719E01
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Any position other than
motor stop position
(Motor in operation)
3-4
Below 1 Ω
Motor stop position
(Gear in original
position)
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the
door lock assembly.
DL
ME–4
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
NEXT
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
5
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
6
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
NEXT
END
ME
CONFIRMATION TEST
ME–5
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
MALFUNCTION SYSTEM:
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Entire combination meter does not operate.
Combination Meter Circuit
ME-24
Light control rheostat malfunction.
Light Control Rheostat Circuit
ME-49
Buzzer does not sound.
Warning Buzzer Circuit
ME-38
Seat belt warning light for driver seat does not operate.
Seat Belt Warning Light Circuit
ME-43
Seat belt warning light for passenger seat does not
operate.
Seat Belt Warning Light Circuit
ME-45
Average fuel consumption/instantaneous fuel
consumption/possible running distance display
malfunction.
Multi-information Display Circuit
ME-53
METER GAUGES:
Symptom
Speedometer malfunction.
Suspected Area
See page
Speedometer Circuit
ME-26
Tachometer malfunction.
Tachometer Circuit
ME-29
Fuel receiver gauge malfunction.
Fuel Receiver Gauge Circuit
ME-32
Engine coolant temperature receiver gauge
malfunction.
Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver gauge Circuit
ME-35
WARNING LIGHTS:
Symptom
Check engine warning light does not come on.
Charge warning light does not come on.
Brake warning light does not come on.
Brake warning light does not go off.
ABS warning light does not come on.
ABS warning light does not go off.
Airbag warning light does not come on.
Suspected Area
See page
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. MIL Circuit for 1GR-FE
ES-397
3. MIL Circuit for 2UZ-FE
ES-479
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Generator
-
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Parking Brake Switch
-
3. Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
ME-22
4. Brake Warning Light Circuit
BC-172
5. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Parking Brake Switch
-
3. Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
ME-22
4. Brake Warning Light Circuit
BC-167
5. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ABS Warning Light Circuit
BC-161
3. Brake Master Cylinder Sub-assembly
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ABS Warning Light Circuit
BC-157
3. Brake Master Cylinder Sub-assembly
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Airbag Warning Light Circuit
RS-282
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
ME
ME–6
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symptom
Airbag warning light does not go off.
Door open warning light does not come on.
Fuel level warning light does not come on.
Low oil pressure warning light does not come on.
VSC warning light does not come on.
VSC warning light does not go off.
A/T oil temp warning light does not come on.
Tire pressure warning light does not come on.
Suspected Area
See page
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Airbag Warning Light Circuit
RS-275
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Door Courtesy Light Switch
LI-63
3. Body ECU
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Fuel Sender Gauge Assembly
ME-21
3. Indication Sensor Assembly
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
ME-21
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. VSC Warning Light Circuit
BC-161
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. VSC Warning Light Circuit
BC-157
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ECM
-
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Tire Pressure Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. Tire Pressure Warning System
TW-58
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
INDICATOR LIGHTS:
Symptom
Fr. FOG indicator light does not come on.
Turn indicator light does not come on.
A/T shift indicator light does not come on.
Hi beam indicator light does not come on.
ME
4WD indicator light does not come on (for 4WD).
4LO indicator light does not come on (for 4WD).
Suspected Area
See page
1. Lighting System
LI-8
2. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Light Control System
LI-8
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
-
3. Wire Harness or Connector
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Light Control System
LI-8
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. 4WD Control Switch Circuit
-
3. 4WD Control ECU
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. 4WD Control Switch Circuit
-
3. 4WD Control ECU
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
ME–7
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
1. Washer Level Warning Switch
Washer level indicator light does not come on (for
Canada).
AUTO LSD indicator light does not come on (for 2WD).
AUTO LSD indicator light does not go off (for 2WD).
VSC OFF indicator light does not come on (for 4WD).
VSC OFF indicator light does not go off (for 4WD).
DAC indicator light does not come on (for 4WD).
DAC indicator light does not go off (for 4WD).
Center diff. lock indicator light does not come on (for
4WD).
SLIP indicator light does not come on.
SLIP indicator light does not go off.
CRUISE indicator light does not come on.
RSCA OFF indicator light does not come on (with Side
Airbag).
RSCA OFF indicator light does not go off (with Side
Airbag).
MAINT REQD indicator light does not come on (for
U.S.A.).
See page
ME-23
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. AUTO LSD Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-196
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. AUTO LSD Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-192
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. 4WD Control Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-178
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. 4WD Control Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-175
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-188
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-184
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Center Diff. Lock Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. 4WD Control ECU
-
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-182
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
BC-180
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Cruise Main Indicator Light Circuit
CC-23
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. RSCA OFF Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
RS-38
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. RSCA OFF Switch
-
2. Wire Harness or Connector
-
3. Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
RS-38
4. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
1. Refer to Troubleshooting
ME-23
2. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
ME
ME–8
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symptom
AIRSUS indicator light does not come on (with Air
Suspension).
ME
Suspected Area
See page
1. Wire Harness or Connector
-
2. Height Control Circuit
SC-18
3. Combination Meter Assembly
ME-59
ME–9
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
C11
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
C10
C9
C8
E113263E01
Symbols (Terminal No.)
TIRE PRESS (C8-1) Body ground
Wiring Color
P-B - Body ground
Terminal Description
Tire pressure signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, TIRE PRESSURE
indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, TIRE PRESSURE
indicator light ON
Below 1 V
ME
ME–10
Symbols (Terminal No.)
AIRSUS HI (C8-2) (*1) Body ground
Wiring Color
Y - Body ground
AIRSUS N (C8-3) (*1) Body ground
Y-B - Body ground
AIRSUS LO (C8-4) (*1) Body ground
BR-B - Body
ground
AIRSUS OFF (C8-5) (*1) Body ground
WASHER (C8-6) (*2) Body ground
CHECK E/G (C8-7) - Body
ground
OIL PRS (C8-8) - Body
ground
RSCA OFF (C8-10) (*3) Body ground
CRUISE (C8-11) - Body
ground
DAC (C8-12) (*4) - Body
ground
ME
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
A/T OIL TEMP (C8-15) Body ground
Y-G - Body ground
V-W - Body ground
R-B - Body ground
LG-B - Body
ground
L-Y - Body ground
LG - Body ground
BR-Y - Body
ground
P - Body ground
Terminal Description
Auto height control signal
Auto height control signal
Auto height control signal
Auto height control signal
Washer level signal
Check engine indicator
light signal
Oil pressure signal
Roll sending of curtain
shield airbag OFF singal
CRUISE indicator light
signal
Downhill assist control
signal
A/T OIL TEMP indicator
light signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, HI indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, HI indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, N indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, N indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, LO indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, LO indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, OFF indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, OFF indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, washer level indicator
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, washer level indicator
light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CHECK E/G warning
light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CHECK E/G warning
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, OIL PRESS indicator
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, OIL PRESS indicator
light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, RSCA OFF indicator
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, RSCA OFF indicator
light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CRUISE indicator light
OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CRUISE indicator light
ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, DAC indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, DAC indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T OIL TEMP indicator
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T OIL TEMP indicator
light ON
Below 1 V
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CHARGE (C8-16) - Body
ground
ALL DOOR INPUT (C817) - Body ground
BRAKE LEVEL (C8-18) Body ground
ACTIVE BRAKE (C8-19) Body ground
Wiring Color
GR - Body ground
V-Y - Body ground
LG - Body ground
B-L - Body ground
Terminal Description
CHARGE warning light
signal
All door condition signal
ME–11
Condition
Specified Condition
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CHARGE warning light
OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CHARGE warning light
ON
Below 1 V
Any door open
Below 1 V
All the door is closed
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, BRAKE warning light
OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, BRAKE warning light
ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, BRAKE warning light
OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, BRAKE warning light
ON
Below 1 V
A/C signal (UART INPUT)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
Signal wave
A/C signal (UART
OUTPUT)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
Signal wave
Brake fluid level warning
light signal
BRAKE warning light
signal
UART IN (C9-2) - Body
ground
BR-B - Body
ground
UART OUT (C9-3) - Body
ground
W-L - Body ground
SP INPUT (C9-4) - Body
ground
GR-R - Body
ground
Speed signal (Input)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, turn the wheel slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
4P-OUT (C9-5) - Body
ground
V-FR - Body
ground
Speed signal (Output)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, turn the wheel slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
TM INPUT (C9-6) - Body
ground
B-W - Body ground
Tachometer signal
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
TEMP COMMUNICATION
INPUT (C9-7) - Body
ground
L-B - Body ground
A/C signal (Temp. input)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
TAU-G INPUT (C9-8) Body ground
R-L - Body ground
Injector No. 1 signal
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
Pulse generation
(See waveform 4)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, driver side seat belt
warning light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, driver side seat belt
warning light blinks
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, passenger side seat belt
warning light blinks
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, passenger side seat belt
warning light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch off
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, passenger side seat belt
warning light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, passenger side seat belt
warning light blinks
Below 1 V
D SEAT BELT INPUT (C912) - Body ground
P SEAT BELT INPUT (C913) - Body ground
ST SIGNAL INPUT (C916) - Body ground
P SEAT BELT OUT (C918) - Body ground
G-Y - Body ground
L-R - Body ground
B-Y - Body ground
LG - Body ground
Driver seat belt warning
light signal
Passenger seat belt
warning light signal (Input)
Start signal
Passenger seat belt
warning light signal
(Output)
ME
ME–12
Symbols (Terminal No.)
KEY INPUT (C9-19) Body ground
A/T (R) (C10-1) - Body
ground
ACTIVE AIRBAG INPUT
(C10-2) - Body ground
Wiring Color
V-G - Body ground
R-Y - Body ground
B-Y - Body ground
FUEL (FR) (C10-3) - Body
ground
BR-R - Body
ground
TAU-B INPUT (C10-5) Body ground
B-O - Body ground
TURN R (C10-6) - Body
ground
L-Y - Body ground
Terminal Description
Ignition key signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
Airbag indicator light
signal
Fuel signal
IG2 signal
Turn indicator light
RH signal
RHEOSTAT (TR) (C10-7) Body ground
W-G - Body ground
Rheostat Signal
D DOOR INPUT (C10-8) Body ground
W-L - Body ground
Driver door condition
signal
ILL+ (C10-9) - Body
ground
TURN L (C10-10) - Body
ground
ME
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
G - Body ground
L-B - Body ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, ignition key is inserted
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, ignition key is not
inserted
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (R) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (R) indicator light
ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, AIRBAG indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, AIRBAG indicator light
ON
8 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, fuel level is FULL
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, fuel level is EMPTY
4 to 5 V
Turn the ignition switch off
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, turn signal RH indicator
light OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the O,
position, turn signal RH indicator
light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, light control rheostat is
turned volume up → volume
down
Pulse generation (See
waveform 5)
Driver door OPEN
Below 1 V
Driver door CLOSE
10 to 14 V
Light control switch off
Below 1 V
Light control switch TAIL
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, turn signal LH indicator
light OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, turn signal LH indicator
light ON
10 to 14 V
Ground (Fuel ground)
Always
Below 1 V
Always
Below 1 V
Illumination signal
Turn indicator light LH
signal
FUEL GND (C10-11) Body ground
P - Body ground
E/G GND (C10-13) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Ground (Engine ground)
IGN2 (C10-15) - Body
ground
Turn the ignition switch off
Below 1 V
R-L - Body ground
IG2 signal
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position
10 to 14 V
+B (C10-16 ) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, VSC OFF (*4), AUTO
LSD (*5) indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, VSC OFF (*4), AUTO
LSD (*5) indicator light ON
Below 1 V
VSC OFF (*4) / AUTO
LSD (*5) (C10-17) - Body
ground
L-W - Body ground
VSC OFF signal (*4)
AUTO LSD signal (*5)
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
VSC TRAC (C10-18) (*4) Body ground
SLIP (C10-20) - Body
ground
4WD (C11-5) (*6) - Body
ground
CTR DIFF LOCK (C11-6)
(*4) - Body ground
Wiring Color
Y-R - Body ground
R - Body ground
W-G - Body ground
G-R - Body ground
4LO (C11-7) (*2) - Body
ground
BR-W - Body
ground
Fr. FOG (C11-10) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
BEAM+ (C11-12) - Body
ground
R-W - Body ground
BEAM- (C11-13) - Body
ground
A/T (L) (C11-14) - Body
ground
A/T (2) (C11-15) - Body
ground
A/T (3) (C11-16) - Body
ground
A/T (4) (C11-17) - Body
ground
A/T (D) (C11-18) - Body
ground
R-W - Body ground
B-L - Body ground
P-L - Body ground
L - Body ground
G - Body ground
W - Body ground
Terminal Description
ME–13
Condition
Specified Condition
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, VSC TRAC indicator
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, VSC TRAC indicator
light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, SLIP indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, SLIP indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, 4WD indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, 4WD indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CTR DIFF LOCK
indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, CTR DIFF LOCK
indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, 4WD indicator light OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, 4WD indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Front fog light signal
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, Fr. FOG indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Hi-beam signal
Always
10 to 14 V
10 to 14 V
Hi-beam signal
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, BEAM indicator light
OFF
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, BEAM indicator light ON
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (L) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (L) indicator light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (2) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (2) indicator light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (3) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (3) indicator light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (4) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (4) indicator light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (D) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (D) indicator light
ON
10 to 14 V
VSC TRAC signal
SLIP signal
4WD indicator light signal
CTR DIFF LOCK signal
Low speed four-wheel
drive signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
ME
ME–14
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
A/T (N) (C11-19) - Body
ground
A/T (P) (C11-20) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
G-W - Body ground
G-B - Body ground
A/T shift indicator light
signal
A/T shift indicator light
signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (N) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (N) indicator light
ON
10 to 14 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (P) indicator light
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position, A/T (P) indicator light
ON
10 to 14 V
*1: with Air Suspension
*2: for Canada
*3: with Side Airbag
*4: for 4WD
*5: for 2WD
*6: for 1GR-FE, 4WD
(a) Waveform 1 (Reference): Using an oscilloscope:
OK
GND
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 km/h (12 mph)
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the cycle of the signal
waveform narrows.
I043789E01
(b) Waveform 2 (Reference): Using an oscilloscope:
OK
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
I043790E02
(c) Waveform 3 (Reference): Using an oscilloscope:
OK
A
GND
ME
415.792 to 419.792 ms
I032122E01
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 100 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
HINT:
As the engine coolant temperature rises, the period
"A" shown in the illustration becomes longer.
Reference
Engine Coolant Temperature
A
Less than 50°C (122.0°F)
96.304 to 100.304 ms
83°C (181.4°F)
231.472 to 235.472 ms
120°C (248.0°F)
383.024 to 387.024 ms
ME–15
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(d) Waveform 4 (Reference): Using an oscilloscope:
OK
Item
Condition
Tool setting
10 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
E123284E02
(e) Waveform 5 (Reference): Using an oscilloscope:
OK
A
Item
GND
I037750E04
Condition
Tool setting
2 V/DIV., 1 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Ignition switch ON, light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
HINT:
Duty ratio changes as the illumination becomes
darker (the period "A" shown in the illustration
becomes longer).
ME
ME–16
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
2.
COMBINATION METER INNER CIRCUIT
C8-2
(AIR SUS (HI)) (*1)
C8-3
(AIR SUS (N)) (*1)
HI
(*1)
N
(*1)
C8-4
(AIR SUS (LO)) (*1)
LO (*1)
C8-5
(AIR SUS (OFF)) (*1)
OFF (*1)
DRIVE CIRCUIT
FR FOG
C11-10 (Fr. FOG)
TURN L
C10-10 (TURN L)
TURN R
C10-6 (TURN R)
HEAD (*5)
ILL
DRIVE CIRCUIT
ILL
P
R
N
D
4
DRIVE
CIRCUIT
*1: with Air
Suspension
*5: for U.S.A.
3
2
L
C11-20 (A/T P)
C10-1 (A/T R)
C11-19 (A/T N)
C11-18 (A/T D)
C11-17 (A/T 4)
C11-16 (A/T 3)
C11-15 (A/T 2)
C11-14 (A/T L)
ME
E116252E02
ME–17
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
TAIL (*4)
BEAM
C11-13 (BEAM-)
C8-17
(ALL DOOR INPUT)
DOOR
DUTY OUT
C9-19 (KEY INPUT)
C10-8
(D DOOR INPUT)
C10-7 (RHEOSTAT (TR))
+B
C10-16 (+B)
TAIL
C10-9 (ILL+)
C10-15 (IGN2)
IG
KEY
D-BELT
D-DOOR
C9-12
(D SEAT BELT INPUT)
C10-13 (E/G INPUT)
C11-12 (BEAM+)
4P OUT
E/G EARTH
C9-5 (4P OUTPUT)
C9-16
(ST SIGNAL INUPT)
ST
O/D TRIP
TR
C9-7 (TEMP COMMUNICATION INPUT)
SPEED
C9-6 (TM INPUT)
C9-4 (SP INPUT)
SI
C9-13
(P SEAT BELT INPUT)
TACHO
DRIVER
FUEL
C10-3 (FUEL (FR))
FS
C10-11 (FUEL (GND))
FE
TEMP
FUEL W
C9-18
(P SEAT BELT OUT)
C9-2 (UART IN)
C9-3 (UART OUT)
DRIVER CIRCUIT
OIL MAINT (*5)
C9-8(TAU-G INPUT)
BZ
ME
C10-5 (TAU-B INPUT)
*4: for Canada
INCLINATION SSR
*5: for U.S.A.
E116112E02
ME–18
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
C10-2
(ACTIVE AIRBAG INPUT)
REVERSE
AIRBAG
C11-4 (ACTIVE ABS)
REVERSE
ABS
C8-19 (ACTIVE BRAKE)
REVERSE
BRAKE
CHARGE
C8-16 (CHARGE)
WASHER (*4)
C8-6 (WASHER) (*4)
OIL PRESS
C8-8 (OIL PRS)
4WD (*2)
C11-5 (4WD) (*2)
4LO (*2)
C11-7 (4LO) (*2)
C11-6
(CTR DIFF LOCK) (*2)
CTR DIFF LOCK (*2)
CHECK ENG
C8-7 (CHECK E/G)
A/T OIL TEMP
C8-15 (A/T OIL TEMP)
CRUISE
C8-11 (CRUISE)
DAC (*2)
C8-12 (DAC) (*2)
SLIP
C10-20 (SLIP)
VSC
C10-18 (VSC TRAC) (*2)
VSC OFF (*2)
AUTO LSD (*3)
C10-17 (VSC OFF) (*2)
(AUTO LSD) (*3)
C8-1 (TIRE PRESS)
REVERSE
TIRE PRS
*1: with Air Suspension
*2: for 4WD
*3: for 2WD
*4: Canada
C8-10 (RSCA OFF) (*6)
RSCA OFF (*1)
*5: U.S.A.
*6: with Side Airbag
ME
E116113E01
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Connector No.
C8
C9
Terminals No.
ME–19
Wire harness side
1
Tire Pressure WARNING ECU (TIRE PRESS)
2
Suspension Control ECU (HI) (*1)
3
Suspension Control ECU (N) (*1)
4
Suspension Control ECU (LO) (*1)
5
Suspension Control ECU (OFF) (*1)
6
Washer Level Sensor (*2)
7
ECM (CHECK ENGINE)
8
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
9
-
10
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly (RSCA OFF) (*3)
11
ECM (CRUISE)
12
ABS & Traction Actuator assembly (DAC) (*4)
13
-
14
-
15
ECM (A/T OIL TEMP)
16
Generator (CHARGE)
17
Main Body ECU (AL DOOR INPUT)
18
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
19
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly (ACTIVE BRAKE)
20
-
1
-
2
A/C Control Amplifier (UART IN)
3
A/C Control Amplifier (UART OUT)
4
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly (SP INPUT)
5
Each part that use the vehicle speed signal (4P OUT)
6
ECM (TM INPUT)
7
A/C Control Amplifier (TEMP COMMUNICATION INPUT)
8
INJECTOR NO. 1 (TAU-G INPUT)
9
-
10
-
11
-
12
Driver Side Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly (INPUT)
13
Passenger Side Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly (INPUT)
14
-
15
-
16
STA Relay (ST SIGNAL INPUT)
17
-
18
Passenger Side Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly (OUTPUT)
19
Main Body ECU (KEY INPUT)
20
-
ME
ME–20
Connector No.
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Terminals No.
1
C10
C11
ME
Wire harness side
Park/Neutral Position Switch (R)
2
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly (ACTIVE AIRBAG INPUT)
3
Fuel Sender Gauge Assembly (FUEL (FR))
4
-
5
IGN Fuse (TAU-B INPUT)
6
Turn Signal Flasher (TURN R)
7
Ground
8
Main Body ECU (D DOOR INPUT)
9
Tail Relay (ILL+)
10
Turn Signal Flasher (TURN L)
11
Ground (Fuel Ground)
12
-
13
Ground (Engine Ground)
14
-
15
GAUGE Fuse (IGN2)
16
DOME Fuse (+B)
17
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly (VSC OFF (*4), AUTO LAD (*5))
18
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly (VSC) (*4)
19
-
20
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly (SLIP)
1
-
2
-
3
-
4
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly (ACTIVE ABS)
5
4WD Control ECU (4WD) (*4)
6
4WD Control ECU (CTR DIFF LOCK) (*4)
7
4WD Control ECU (4LO) (*4)
8
-
9
-
10
Front Fog Light Relay (Fr. FOG)
11
-
12
Headlight (HI) Fuse (BEAM+)
13
Light Control Switch (BEAM-)
14
Transmission Control Switch (L)
15
Transmission Control Switch (2)
16
Park/Neutral Position Switch (3)
17
Transmission Control Switch (4)
18
Transmission Control Switch (D)
19
Park/Neutral Position Switch (N)
20
Park/Neutral Position Switch (P)
*1: with Air Suspension
*2: for Canada
*3: with Side Airbag
*4: for 4WD
*5: for 2WD
*6: for 1GR-FE, 4WD
ME–21
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SPEEDOMETER
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Using a speedometer meter tester, check the
speedometer indication according to the table
below.
Reference: mph (for U.S.A.)
Chassis dynamometer indication
Acceptable range
20 mph
20.0 to 23.0 mph
40 mph
40.0 to 43.5 mph
60 mph
60.0 to 64.0 mph
80 mph
80.0 to 84.5 mph
100 mph
100.0 to 105.0 mph
Reference: mph (for Canada, Mexico)
Chassis dynamometer indication
Acceptable range
Data in ( ) are for reference
20 km/h
(17.5 to 21.5 km/h)
40 km/h
38.0 to 42.0 km/h
60 km/h
58.0 to 63.0 km/h
80 km/h
78.0 to 84.0 km/h
100 km/h
98.5 to 104.5 km/h
120 km/h
119.0 to 125.0 km/h
140 km/h
139.0 to 146.0 km/h
160 km/h
159.0 to 167.0 km/h
NOTICE:
Tire wear, as well as over or under inflation
will cause errors.
(2) Check the deviation from the acceptable value
of the speedometer indication.
Reference:
Below 0.3 km/h (0.19 mph)
2.
INSPECT TACHOMETER
(a) Check operation.
(1) Connect the tune-up test tachometer and start
the engine.
NOTICE:
• Reversing the connection of the
tachometer will damage the transistors
and the insides of the diodes.
• When removing or installing the
tachometer, be careful not to drop or
subject it to heavy shocks.
(2) Compare the result of the test with the standard
indication.
DC 13.5 V, at 25°C (77°F)
Reference: 2UZ-FE
Chassis dynamometer indication (r/min)
Acceptable range (r/min)
Data in ( ) are for reference
700
630 to 770
1,000
(900 to 1,100)
2,000
(1,850 to 2,150)
ME
ME–22
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Acceptable range (r/min)
Data in ( ) are for reference
Chassis dynamometer indication (r/min)
3,000
2,800 to 3,200
4,000
(3,800 to 4,200)
5,000
4,800 to 5,200
6,000
(5,750 to 6,250)
Standard indication (rpm)
Acceptable range (rpm)
Data in ( ) are for reference
700
630 to 770
Reference: 1GR-FE
1,000
(900 to 1,100)
2,000
(1,850 to 2,150)
3,000
2,800 to 3,200
4,000
(3,800 to 4,200)
5,000
4,800 to 5,100
6,000
(5,750 to 6,250)
3.
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE
(a) Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, then check the position
of the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Needle position is on (EMPTY).
(c) Connect terminals 2 and 3 on the wire harness side
connector of the fuel sender gauge.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, then check the position
of the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Needle position is on (FULL).
4.
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, then check that the fuel
level needle indicates EMPTY and the fuel level
warning light comes on.
OK:
Fuel level warning light comes on.
5.
INSPECT SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT (for Driver
Side)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and check that the
warning light blinks.
(b) Fasten the outer belt to the inner belt and check that
the warning light goes off.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the front seat inner
belt assembly (driver side), and connect the
terminal on the wire harness side connector to body
ground.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and check that the
warning light blinks.
6.
INSPECT LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE WARNING
LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the low oil pressure
switch.
Fuel Sender Gauge Connector
Front View:
FE
FS
I030899E13
ME
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ME–23
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Ground the terminal of the wire harness side
connector, then check the low oil pressure warning
light.
OK:
Low engine oil pressure warning light comes
on.
7.
INSPECT BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the parking brake warning light.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the parking
brake switch.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Ground the terminal of the wire harness side
connector, then check the parking brake
warning light.
OK:
Brake warning light comes on.
(b) Inspect the brake fluid level warning light.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the brake fluid
level warning switch.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Connect a terminal to the other terminal of the
wire harness side connector, then check the
brake fluid level warning switch.
OK:
Brake warning light comes on.
8.
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
Float up (switch off): 10 kΩ or higher
(d) Use a syphon, etc. to take fluid out of the reservoir
tank.
(e) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
Float down (switch on): Below 1 Ω
(f) Pour the fluid back in the reservoir tank.
9.
INSPECT SEAT BELT WARNING BUZZER (for Driver
Side)
(a) Check the warning buzzer function.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and check that
the driver's seat belt warning sounds if the
driver's seat belt is not fastened.
(2) Check that the buzzer stops in about 4 to 8
seconds.
10. INSPECT KEY REMINDER WARNING BUZZER
(a) Check the warning buzzer function.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off, and check that the
key reminder warning sounds when the ignition
key is inserted in the key cylinder and the front
driver side door is opened.
ME
ME–24
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
11. INSPECT TRIP METER
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to ON, and check that
the mode indication changes in the order of
"ODO" → "TRIP A" → "TRIP B" → "ODO" by
pressing the trip switch.
HINT:
When turning the ignition switch to the ON
position, the first mode that appears on the
display is the previously indicated mode.
(2) Check that the indicated data in "TRIP A" and
"TRIP B" is reset by pressing the trip switch for
more than 0.5 seconds.
I033950
12. REMOVE WASHER LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Inspect the circuit.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the washer level
warning switch.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(3) Connect the terminal of the wire harness side
connector and body ground, then check the
condition of the washer level warning light.
13. OIL MAINTENANCE INDICATOR RESETTING
PROCEDURE
Indicator Condition:
State
Condition
Specified State
Blinking
The vehicle runs 4,500 to 5,000 miles after
the previous setting
The indicator blinks for 12 seconds after the
ignition switch is ON (including 3 seconds for
a bulb check)
Continuously Illuminated
The vehicle runs over 5,000 miles after the
previous setting
The indicator is continuously illuminated after
the ignition switch is ON.
(a) Set the display window to ODO.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) While pressing the reset switch, turn the ignition
switch ON. Keep pressing the reset switch for at
least 5 seconds to complete the reset procedure.
Check that the "OIL MAINT" indicator light goes off.
HINT:
• If the ignition switch is turned off during the reset
procedure:
LCD: off
IND: off
• If the reset switch is not pressed for at least 5
seconds during the reset procedure:
LCD: return to ODO
IND: previous state
ME
ME–50
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Operating Light Control Rheostat does not Change Light Brightness
WIRING DIAGRAM
R13
Light Control Rheostat
ILLE
T
Combination Meter Assembly
From Another Illumination
J/C
6
A
J8
W-G
3
E
J9
W-G
7
C10
J/C
A
J15
A
J14
W-B
5
RHEOSTAT
(TR)
W-B
J/C
C
J10
G
4
J16 J/C
C
J10
G
B
B
A
J11
9
C10 ILL+
G
Driver Side J/B
G
TAIL Relay
5
To Multiplex
Body ECU
1L
J7
J/C
J20
J/C
8
IG
Y-R
1
Y-R
H A
H
Y-R
A
1
TAIL
3
5
2
1
2
IG1
1C
1J
I18
Ignition Switch
Engine Room R/B
ALT
2
1
1C
AM1
2 1
2
2
2 AM1
J/B
B
1
2
2
L-W
2
2
BR
(*2)
B
L-Y
IG1 4
W-L
13
7
IM1
BR
C10 E/G GND
J5 J/C
ME
A
Battery
IG
BR (*1)
EE
ED
*1: 2UZ-FE
*2: 1GR-FE
A133756E01
ME–51
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TAILLIGHT
(a) Check that the tail light comes on when the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position and light control
switch is in the TAIL or HEAD position.
OK:
Tail light comes on.
NG
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK ILLUMINATION
(a) Check that the illumination of the radio and player, center
cluster module switch, etc. can be adjusted by the light
control rheostat switch.
OK:
The illumination can be adjusted.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C10 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Combination Meter Assembly
(Right Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-9 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON and
light control switch TAIL
or HEAD
10 to 14 V
ILL+
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
C10
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-13 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
E/G GND
E113267E02
OK
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ME
ME–52
4
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT - COMBINATION
METER)
(a) Disconnect the R13 and C10 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Light Control Rheostat Wire Harness View:
R13
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R13-3 (-) - C10-7 (RHEOSTAT
(TR))
Always
Below 1 Ω
R13-3 (-) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
(-)
NG
Combination Meter Assembly (Right Side of
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10
RHEOSTAT (TR)
I039610E01
OK
5
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
(a) Remove the light control rheostat with connector still
connected.
Light Control Rheostat Wire Harness View:
R13
(-)
I038343E01
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
OK
A
ME
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R13-3 (-) - Body ground
Light control rheostat is
turned volume up →
volume down
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
GND
Waveform:
Item
Condition
I037750E04
Tool setting
2 V/DIV., 1 ms./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Ignition switch ON and light control
switch TAIL or HEAD
ME–53
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
HINT:
Duty ratio changes as the illumination becomes darker
(period "A" shown in the illustration becomes longer).
NG
REPLACE LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
6
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the R13 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Light Control Rheostat Wire Harness View:
R13
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R13-1 (IG) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
R13-4 (T) - Body ground
Light control switch TAIL
or HEAD
10 to 14 V
IG
E
T
E069145E08
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R13-5 (E) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–54
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Multi-display Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Confirm that the speedometer, the tachometer, the fuel receiver gauge and SFI system are normal, then
check this circuit.
Refer to SFI system for 1GR-FE (See page ES-31) or 2UZ-FE (See page ES-35).
HINT:
If this circuit has a malfunction, average fuel consumption display/instantaneous fuel consumption display/
possible running distance display cannot be displayed correctly.
ME
ME–55
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
A/C Control Amplifier
19
DMOT A17
BR-B
20
DMIN A17
W-L
3
C9 UART
OUT
J26 (*1)
J27 (*2)
J/C
ECM
#10
2
C9 UART IN
2
E6
R-L
A (*1)
A (*1)
D (*2)
D (*2)
8
IM2
R-L
R-L
8
TAU-G
C9
INPUT
J/C
B
J8
B-O
D
J9
5
C10 TAU-B
INPUT
B-O
Driver Side J/B
IGN
11
1J
6
1D
B-R
I18
Ignition Switch
Engine Room R/B
AM2
B
2
1
2
2
R
7 AM2
IG2 6
Battery
*1: for 2UZ-FE
*2: for 1GR-FE
I038353E01
ME
ME–56
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (TAU-B)
Combination Meter Assembly (Right
Side of Vehicle) Connector Front View:
(a) Remove the combination meter assembly.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-5 (TAU-B INPUT) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
C10
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TAU-B INPUT
E113267E03
OK
2
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (TAU-G)
Combination Meter Assembly (Left
Side of Vehicle) Connector Front View:
(a) Check the input signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assembly.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal C9-8 (TAU-G
INPUT) and body ground.
(3) Start the engine.
C9
TAU-G INPUT
E113265E05
(4) Check the signal waveform according to the
condition(s) in the table below.
Waveform:
ME
Item
Condition
Tool setting
10 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
HINT:
As the engine speed goes higher, the frequency
becomes shorter.
A005115E03
NG
Go to step 3
ME–57
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the E6 and C9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
ECM Wire Harness View:
Tester connection
Condition
E6-2 (#10) - C9-8 (TAU-G INPUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
E6-2 (#10) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Specified condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
E6
#10
Combination Meter Assembly
(Left Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
C9
TAU-G INPUT
C
E116116E01
OK
4
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY (LCD DISPLAY)
(a) Check the LCD display appears.
OK:
LCD display appears.
NG
OK
GO TO AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
ME
ME–58
5
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - COMBINATION
METER)
Air Conditioning Amplifier Wire Harness View:
A17
DMIN
DMOT
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
(a) Disconnect the A17 and C9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
A17-19 (DMOT) - C9-2 (UART IN)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A17-19 (DMOT) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A17-20 (DMIN) - C9-3 (UART
OUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A17-20 (DMIN) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
UART IN
C9
UART OUT
I038359E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
Specified condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ME–1
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
METER
PARTS LOCATION
REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSEMBLY
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- DOME FUSE
- AM2 FUSE
- SHORT PIN
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WASHER LEVEL SENSOR
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ME
E115629E01
ME–2
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
SKID CONTROL ECU
(ABS & TRACTION
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY)
A/C CONTROL AMPLIFIER
PASSENGER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
LIGHT CONTROL
RHEOSTAT
4WD CONTROL ECU
ECM
ODO/TRIP
SWITCH
OCCUPANT DETECTION
SENSOR
DRIVER SIDE J/B
- BODY ECU
CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT
ASSEMBLY (PASSENGER SIDE)
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT
ASSEMBLY (DRIVER SIDE)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
ME
E115630E02
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
2UZ-FE:
ME–3
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
1GR-FE:
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
ME
E115631E01
METER – COMBINATION METER
ME–61
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL INCLINATION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 COMBINATION METER COVER
3.
INSTALL SPEEDOMETER GLASS
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Pull the positions shown in the illustration in the
arrow mark direction to make the check pins unseen
form the surface.
B064629
(b) Check that the connector on the instrument panel
side is in place.
(c) Install the combination meter assembly with the 3
screws.
(d) Tighten the screw shown in the illustration and
check that the check pin protrudes.
B063039
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
3.
INCLINATION SENSOR ZERO DEGREE
CORRECTION
NOTICE:
• When replacing or removing/installing the
combination meter assembly and inclination
sensor assembly, be sure to perform zero degree
correction of the inclination sensor.
• When performing zero degree correction, install
the combination meter assembly and perform it in
level surface.
• Also perform zero degree correction when the
body level setting is inclined because of vehicle
height adjustment.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) While pressing the RESET switch, turn the ignition
switch on.
(c) Within 5 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
on, repeat pressing and releasing the RESET
switch 3 times and keep holding the last press for
more than 5 seconds. (Buzzer sounds for a second)
NOTICE:
If the buzzer does not sound, perform this
procedure from the beginning.
ME
ME–62
METER – COMBINATION METER
(d) Release the RESET switch when buzzer sounds.
IG+
RESET S/W
BUZZER
OFF
OFF
ON
ON
ON
OFF
<= 5s
<= 5s
5s
800 Hz
800 Hz
1s
5s
1s
<= 30s
MODE
DURING MODE JUDGMENT
CORRECTION MODE
NORMAL
B064233E01
(e) Press the RESET switch again and keep pressing
for more than 5 seconds. (Buzzer sounds for a
second again)
HINT:
• When the buzzer sounds twice, reset operation is
completed.
• The buzzer sound of the first and second time is
the same.
NOTICE:
If the buzzer does not sound or keep sounding
for more than 1 second, perform the procedure
from the beginning.
ME
ME–25
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Entire Combination Meter does not Operate
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side J/B
I18
Ignition Switch
6
B-R
R
7 AM2
IG2 6
C2
IC4
R
Combination Meter
Assembly
4
GAUGE
J7
J/C
15
C10 IGN2
F
J9
R
16
C10 +B
7
IM1
BR
13
C10 E/G GND
J/C
R
R
D
R-L
1G
1D
D
H
J8
Engine Room R/B
DOME
2
2
1
1
2
Short Pin
2
BR
(*2)
W
2
BR
(*1)
AM2
2
2
1
2
B
Battery
EE
ED
*1: 2UZ-FE
*2: 1GR-FE
C
E116279E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE
(a) Check the AM2 fuse in the engine room R/B.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(b) Check the GAUGE fuse in the driver side J/B.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Check the DOME fuse in the engine room R/B.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
ME
ME–26
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C10 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Combination Meter Assembly
(Right Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
C10
+B
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C10-16 (+B) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
C10-15 (IGN2) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
IGN2
E/G GND
E113267E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C10-13 (E/G GND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ME–58
METER – COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
BODY ELECTRICAL
METER
COMPONENTS
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
ME
B120190E03
METER – COMBINATION METER
ME–59
NO. 1 COMBINATION METER COVER
INCLINATION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
SPEEDOMETER GLASS
B134264E02
REMOVAL
1.
7 Clips
B062746E01
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 7 clips.
(b) Disconnect the connectors and remove the
instrument cluster finish panel sub-assembly.
ME
ME–60
METER – COMBINATION METER
2.
REMOVE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws.
(b) Loosen the 2 bolts and remove the combination
meter assembly.
B062747
DISASSEMBLY
6 Claws
1.
REMOVE SPEEDOMETER GLASS
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disengage the 6 claws and remove the
speedometer glass.
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 COMBINATION METER COVER
(a) Remove the 10 screws and No. 1 combination
meter cover.
3.
REMOVE INCLINATION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and inclination sensor
assembly.
B062754E01
B062755
ME
B062756
ME–27
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Speedometer Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & Traction Actuator Assembly
SP1
C
12
S28
Combination Meter Assembly
4
C9 SP INPUT
E110183E11
ME
ME–28
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ABS & TRACTION
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the S28 and C9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Brake Actuator Assembly Wire
Harness Connector Front View:
S28
Tester Connection
Condition
S28-12 (SP1) - C9-4 (SP INPUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
S28-12 (SP1) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SP1
Combination Meter Assembly
(Left Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
C9
SP INPUT
A133752E01
OK
2
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the C9 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Brake Actuator Assembly Wire
Harness Connector Front View:
S28
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S28-12 (SP1) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
ME
SP1
A133753E01
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
ME–29
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the input signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assembly.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal C9-4 and body
ground.
(3) Start the engine.
Combination Meter Assembly
(Left Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
C9
SP INPUT
E113265E01
(4) Check the signal waveform according to the
condition(s) in the table below.
GND
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 km/h (12.4 mph)
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the cycle of the signal
waveform narrows.
A005135E07
NG
GO TO BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–30
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Tachometer Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
When turn the ignition switch to the ON position, the combination meter assembly communicates with the
ECM by the direct line.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
ECM
TACH
1
E8
13
C11 TM IN
E118032E04
ME
ME–31
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of Vehicle)
Wire Harness View:
C9
TM INPUT
(a) Check the input signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assembly with the
connector(s) still connected.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals C9-6 (TM
INPUT) and body ground.
(3) Start the engine.
(4) Check the signal waveform according to the
condition(s) in the table below.
Item
Condition
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Vehicle Condition
Engine idle speed
OK:
The waveform is displayed as shown in the
illustration.
NG
Go to step 2
GND
E123279E02
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–32
2
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the C9 and E9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
ECM Wire Harness View:
E7
TACH
Combination Meter Assembly Wire Harness View:
(Left Side of Vehicle)
C9
TM INPUT
E113266E04
OK
REPLACE ECM
ME
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
TACH (E9-1) - TM
INPUT(C9-6)
Always
Below 1 Ω
TM INPUT (C9-6) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ME–33
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Fuel Receiver Gauge Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
F14
Fuel Pump Fuel Sender
Y-B
2
3
BR-R
2
IE1
Y-B
11
C10 FUEL GND
1
IE1
BR-R
3
C10 FUEL (FR)
I032726E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
(a) Disconnect the F10 connector from the fuel sender
gauge assembly.
(b) Check the meter indicator conditions according to the
table below.
Standard
Fuel Sender Gauge Connector
Front View:
Wire connection
Condition
Specified condition
2-3
Short circuit (Ignition
switch ON)
Fuel gauge indicates
"F" or more
(Combination meter)
F14
I030899E16
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the fuel sender gauge assembly.
ME
ME–34
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(b) Check that the float position is between E and F.
(c) Measure the resistance between terminals 2 and 3 of the
connector according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
F
1/2
11.9 mm
Float level
Float position mm (in.)
Resistance (Ω)
F
88.6 (3.49) +- 3 (0.12)
4.0 +- 1
1/2
6.4 (0.25)
59
E
102.9 (4.05) +- 3 (0.12)
110.0 +- 2.5
E
I038335E01
NG
INSPECT INCLINATION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the C10 and F14 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Fuel Sender Gauge Connector
Front View:
F14
FS
FE
Combination Meter Assembly (Right
Side of Vehicle) Connector Front View:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C10-3 (FUEL (FR)) - F14-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
C10-11 (FUEL GND) - F14-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10
FUEL (FR)
FUEL GND
I038340E01
OK
4
ME
INSPECT INCLINATION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the inclination sensor assembly.
NG
REPLACE INCLINATION SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ME–35
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–36
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver Gauge Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
ECM
7
C9
14
THWO E7
TEMP
COMMUNICATION
INPUT
E2
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
THW
21
E4
E2
E4
2
1
28
E123280E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If there is an open or short in the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit, the ECM outputs DTCs.
Perform troubleshooting with the "SFI System" (See page ES-31 for 1GR-FE) (See page ES-35 for 2UZFE).
1
ME
CHECK DTC
(a) Check if DTC is output.
Result
Proceed to
DTC P0115 is not output.
A
DTC P0115 is output.
B
B
GO TO ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ME–37
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
A
2
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
Combination Meter Assembly Wire Harness View:
(Left Side of Vehicle)
C9
TEMP COMMUNICATION
INPUT
(a) Check the input signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assembly with
connectors still connected.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminal C9-7
(TEMP COMMUNICATION INPUT) and body
ground.
(3) Start the engine.
(4) Check the signal waveform according to the
condition(s) in the table below.
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 100 ms/DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
HINT:
As the coolant temperature rises, the period "A"
shown in the illustration becomes longer.
A
GND
NG
Go to step 3
415.792 to 419.792 ms
E123282E02
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–38
3
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the C9 and E7 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
ECM Wire Harness View:
Tester Connection
E7
THWO
Combination Meter Assembly Wire Harness View:
(Left Side of Vehicle)
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
THWO (E7-14) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
C9
TEMP COMMUNICATION
INPUT
E113266E05
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ME
Condition
TEMP COMMUNICATION INPUT
(C9-7) - THWO (E7-14)
REPLACE ECM
ME–39
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Warning Buzzer does not Sound
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Body ECU
15
KSWO B6
19
C9 KEY INPUT
V-G
11
13
DBKL B4
8
D DOOR
C10
INPUT
W-L
DCY2 B6
G-Y
B
J21
D
J20
C
J8
G-Y
C
J9
G-Y
K
J44
L
12
C9
D SEAT BELT
INPUT
J/C
D
J20
8
IE1
D
G-Y
J43
(*1)
(*1)
10
L
BK1
(*2)
G-Y
(*2)
J53
J/C
1
W-B
BK1
(*1)
W-B
B (*1)
B
B15
Front Seat Inner Belt
Assembly (Driver Side)
J/C
W-B
(*2)
BL
A
J43
A
J44
W-B
(*2)
4
3
*1: without Driving Position Memory
ME
*2: with Driving Position Memory
C
E116114E01
ME–40
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BUZZER
(a) Check that all of the warning buzzers sound.
Result
Proceed to
All warning buzzers do not sound
A
Key reminder warning buzzer does not sound
B
Seat belt warning buzzer does not sound
C
B
Go to step 2
C
Go to step 4
A
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
2
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C9 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Combination Meter Assembly
(Left Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
C9
KEY INPUT
E113265E02
ME
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C9-19 (KEY INPUT) Body ground
Key is inserted
Below 1 V
C9-19 (KEY INPUT) Body ground
Key is not inserted
10 to 14 V
ME–41
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the C10 connector.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Combination Meter Assembly
(Right Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C10
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C10-8 (D DOOR INPUT) Body ground
Door is open
Below 1 V
C10-8 (D DOOR INPUT) Body ground
Door is closed
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 3
D DOOR INPUT
E113265E03
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - MULTIPLEX NETWORK
BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B6 and C9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Multiplex Network Body ECU Connector
Front View:
KSWO
B6
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B6-15 (KSWO) - C9-19 (KEY
INPUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
B6-15 (KSWO) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
KEY INPUT
C9
I038349E01
ME
ME–42
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the B6 and C10 connectors.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Multiplex Network Body ECU Connector
Front View:
DCY2
B6
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B6-11 (DCY2) - C10-8 (D DOOR
INPUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
B6-11 (DCY2) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Combination Meter Assembly (Right Side of
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C10
D DOOR INPUT
I038350E01
OK
GO TO KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C9 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Combination Meter Assembly
(Left Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C9-12 (D SEAT BELT
INPUT) - Body ground
Seat belt is unfastened
Below 1 Ω
C9-12 (D SEAT BELT
INPUT) - Body ground
Seat belt is fastened
10 kΩ or higher
C9
NG
D SEAT BELT INPUT
E113265E04
ME
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
Go to step 5
ME–43
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
5
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the B12 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Connector Front View:
B15
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B15-3 - B15-4
Seat belt is unfastened
Below 1 Ω
B15-3 - B15-4
Seat belt is fastened
10 kΩ or higher
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly (Driver Side)
B059092E09
NG
GO TO KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ME
ME–44
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Driver Side Seat Belt Warning Light does not Operate
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assembly
Body ECU
J/C
13
DBKL B4
B
G-Y
J21
J/C
D
J20
G-Y
C
J8
8
IE1
D
J43
C
J8
G-Y
12
C9
D SEAT BELT
INPUT
J/C
D
J20
G-Y
(*1)
K
J44
L
(*1)
10
L
BK1
(*2)
G-Y
(*2)
J53
J/C
1
W-B
BK1
(*1)
W-B
B (*1)
B
B15
Front Seat Inner Belt
Assembly (Driver Side)
J/C
W-B
(*2)
BL
A
J43
A
J44
W-B
(*2)
4
3
*1: without Driving Position Memory
*2: with Driving Position Memory
C
ME
E116115E01
ME–45
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C9 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Combination Meter Assembly
(Left Side of Vehicle) Connector
Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C9-12 (D SEAT BELT
INPUT) - Body ground
Seat belt is unfastened
Below 1 Ω
C9-12 (D SEAT BELT
INPUT) - Body ground
Seat belt is fastened
10 kΩ or higher
C9
NG
Go to step 2
D SEAT BELT INPUT
E113265E04
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
2
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the B15 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
B15-3 - B15-4
Seat belt is unfastened
Below 1 Ω
B15-3 - B15-4
Seat belt is fastened
10 kΩ or higher
B15
Specified Condition
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly (Driver Side)
I045351E01
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ME
ME–46
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Front Passenger Side Seat Belt Warning Light Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
D3
Passenger Seat Belt
Warning Light
Combination Meter Assembly
PBEW
IG+
18
C9
LG
3
2
P SEAT BELT
OUTPUT
to IG1 Fuse
Y-R
Airbag Sensor Assembly Center
FSR+
FSRPBEW
1
3
A33 A34
(*1) (*2)
10
2
A33 A34
(*1) (*2)
2
A32
W
1
BI1
B
4
BI1
L-R
13
C9
P SEAT BELT
INPUT
Occupant Detection ECU
FSR-
4
O3
B
8
FSR+ O3
W
9
O3
L
BSW
B16 Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly (Passenger Side)
2
*1: with Side Airbag
5
O3
BGND
GR
1
*2: without Side Airbag
I045360E01
ME
ME–47
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
SYSTEM CHECK (INDICATOR CHECK)
(a) Disconnect the A32 connector.
(b) Check the operation of the warning light according to the
table below.
Standard
Wire Harness View:
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
PBEW
A32
H040065E28
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
No connection
Ignition switch ON
Warning light OFF
A32-2 (PBEW) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
Warning light Blinks
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
SYSTEM CHECK (INDICATOR CHECK)
(a) Connect the A32 connector.
(b) Check the operation of the warning light according to the
table below.
Standard
Condition
Bulb Condition
Result
Ignition switch ON
(Passenger does not sit
on)
OFF
OK
Ignition switch ON
(Passenger sits on)
Blinks
OK
Ignition switch ON
(Passenger sits on and
seat belt is fastened)
OFF
OK
Ignition switch ON
(Passenger sits on and
seat belt is unfastened)
Blinks
OK
Check with the auto cut off switch in the AUTO position
(w/ airbag cut off switch).
NG
GO TO AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–48
3
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the A32 and C9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
PBEW
A32
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A32-2 (PBEW) - C9-13 (P SEAT
BELT INPUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
C9-13 (P SEAT BELT INPUT) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
C9
P SEAT BELT INPUT
I045389E02
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - PASSENGER SEAT BELT
WARNING LIGHT)
(a) Disconnect the D3 and C9 connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
Passenger Seat
Belt Warning Light
PBEW
D3
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D3-3 (PBEW) - C9-18 (P SEAT
BELT OUTPUT)
Always
Below 1 Ω
D3-3 (PBEW) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Combination Meter Assembly (Left Side of
Vehicle) Connector Front View:
C9
ME
P SEAT BELT OUTPUT
I038356E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ME–49
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
5
INSPECT PASSENGER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the D3 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
D3
Passenger Seat
Belt Warning Light
PBEW
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D3-2 (PBEW) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
I038357E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
AV–3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
10 SPEAKER SYSTEM:
Steering Pad Switch
Combination Meter
Antenna
Spiral Cable
Speed Signal
Switch Signal
Radio Receiver
(Master Unit)
Television Display
Assembly
(Slave Unit) (*1)
Stereo Component
Amplifier
Sound Signal
(*1)
(Slave Unit)
Speakers
Sound Signal
Stereo Jack Adapter
Sound Signal
(*1)
: AVC-LAN
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
E119757E03
AV
AV–4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
6 SPEAKER SYSTEM:
Steering Pad Switch
Combination Meter
Antenna
Spiral Cable
Speed Signal
Switch Signal
Radio Receiver
(Master Unit)
Television Display
Assembly
(Slave Unit) (*1)
(*1)
Sound Signal
Speakers
Stereo Jack Adapter
Sound Signal
Sound Signal
(*1)
: AVC-LAN
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
E119758E03
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–5
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
DISC PLAYER OUTLINE
(a) A CD player uses a laser pickup to read digital
signals recorded on CDs. By converting the digital
signals to analog, music and other content can be
played.
CAUTION:
Do not look directly at the laser pickup because
the CD player uses an invisible laser beam. Be
sure to operate the player only as instructed.
NOTICE:
• Do not disassemble any part of the CD player.
• Do not apply oil to the CD player.
• Do not insert anything but a CD into the CD
player.
(b) Usable discs
(1) The CD player can only play audio CDs, CD-Rs
(CD-Recordable), and CD-RWs (CDReWritable) that have any of the following
marks:
E119759
(c) Precautions for use of discs
NOTICE:
• Copy-protected CDs cannot be played.
• CD-Rs and CD-RWs may not be played
depending on the recording conditions or
characteristics of the discs, or due to
damage, dirt, or deterioration caused by
leaving the discs in the cabin for a long time.
• Unfinalized CD-Rs and CD-RWs cannot be
played.
• Keep the discs away from dirt. Be careful not
to damage the discs or leave your
fingerprints on them.
• Hold discs by the outer edge and center hole
with the label side up.
• Leaving the disc exposed halfway out of the
slot for a long time after pressing the disc
eject button may cause deformation of the
disc, making the disc unusable.
• If discs have adhesive tape, stickers, CDR
labels, or any traces of such labels attached,
the discs may not be ejected or player
malfunctions may result.
AV
AV–6
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• Keep the discs away from direct sunlight.
(Exposure to direct sunlight may cause
deformation of the disc, making the disc
unusable.)
• Do not use odd-shaped CDs because these
may cause player malfunctions.
• Do not use discs whose recording portion is
transparent or translucent because they may
not be inserted, ejected, or played normally.
HINT:
• When it is cold or it is raining, if the windows mist
up, mist and also dew may form in the player. In
such a case, the CD may skip or the CD may
stop in the middle of play. Ventilate or dehumidify
the cabin for a while before using the player.
• The CD may skip if the player experiences strong
vibrations when the vehicle is driven on rough
road or similar uneven surface(s).
(d) Cleaning
NOTICE:
Do not use a lens cleaner because it may cause
a malfunction in the pickup portion of the player.
I100151
2.
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a
soft dry cloth such as an eyeglass cleaner for
plastic lenses from the inside to the outside in a
radial direction.
NOTICE:
• Pressing on the disc by hand or rubbing
the disc with a hard cloth may scratch the
disc surface.
• Use of solvent such as a record spray,
antistatic agent, alcohol, benzine, and
thinner, or a chemical cloth may cause
damage to the disc, making the disc
unusable.
MP3/WMA OUTLINE
(a) Playable MP3 file standards
Compatible standard
MP3 (MPEG1 LAYER3, MPEG2 LSF LAYER 3)
Compatible sampling frequency
•
•
MPEG1 LAYER3: 32, 44.1, 48 (kHz)
MPEG2 LSF LAYER3: 16, 22.05, 24 (kHz)
•
MPEG1 LAYER3: 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 160, 192, 224, 256, 320
(kbps)
MPEG2 LSF LAYER3: 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 144, 160 (kbps)
Compatible with VBR
Compatible bit rate
Compatible channel mode
•
•
Stereo, joint stereo, dual channel, monaural
(b) Playable WMA file standards
AV
Compatible standard
WMA Ver. 9
Compatible sampling frequency
32, 44.1, 48 (kHz)
Compatible bit rate
•
•
Ver. 9: CBR48, 64, 80, 96, 128, 160, 192, 256, 320 (kbps)
Compatible with playback of channel 2 only
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–7
(c) ID3 tag and WMA tag
(1) Additional textual information called ID3 tag can
be input to MP3 files. Information such as song
titles and artist names can be stored.
HINT:
This player is compatible with the ID3 tags of ID3
Ver. 1.0 and 1.1, and ID3 Ver. 2.2 and 2.3.
(Number of characters complies with ID3 Ver.
1.0 and 1.1.)
(2) Additional textual information called WMA tag
can be input to WMA files. Information such as
song titles and artist names can be stored.
(d) Usable media
(1) Only CD-ROMs, CD-Rs (CD-Recordable), and
CD-RWs (CD-ReWritable) only can be used to
play MP3/WMA files.
NOTICE:
• CD-Rs and CD-RWs are more easily
affected by a hot and humid environment
than discs used for normal audio CDs. For
this reason, some CD-Rs and CD-RWs
may not be played.
• If there are fingerprints or scratches on
the disc, the disc may not be played or the
CD may skip.
• Some CD-Rs and CD-RWs deteriorate if
they are left in the cabin for a long time.
• Keep CD-Rs and CD-RWs in a storage
case that is impenetrable to light.
(e) Usable media format
(1) Usable media format
Disc format
CD-ROM Mode 1, CD-ROM XA Mode 2 Form1
File format
ISO9660 Level 1 and Level 2 (Joliet, Romeo)
HINT:
• As for MP3/WMA files written in any format
other than those above, the contents of the
files may not be played normally or the file
names or folder names may not be displayed
correctly.
• This player is compatible with multi-session
discs and can play CD-Rs and CD-RWs on
which MP3/WMA files are added. However,
only the first session can be played.
• Discs whose first session includes both music
data and MP3 or WMA format data cannot be
played.
(2) Standard and restrictions
Maximum directory levels
8 levels
Maximum number of characters for a folder name/file name
32 characters
Maximum number of folders
192 (Including empty folders, route folders, and folders that do not
contain MP3/WMA files)
Maximum number of files in a disc
255 (Including non-MP3/WMA files)
AV
AV–8
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(f)
3.
File names
(1) Only files with an extension of ".mp3" or ".wma"
can be recognized and played as MP3 or WMA
files.
(2) Save MP3 or WMA files with an extension of
".mp3" or ".wma".
NOTICE:
If saving non-MP3 or non-WMA files with an
extension of ".mp3" or ".wma", those files
are wrongly recognized as MP3 or WMA files
and played. A loud noise may occur and
damage to the speaker may result.
AVC-LAN DESCRIPTION
(a) What is AVC-LAN?
Example:
Radio Receiver
(Resistor 60 to 80 Ω)
AVC-LAN
Stereo Component Amplifier
I100319E09
AV
AVC-LAN, an abbreviation for "Audio Visual
Communication Local Area Network", is a united
standard developed by the manufacturers in
affiliation with Toyota Motor Corporation. This
standard pertains to audio and visual signals as well
as switch and communication signals.
(b) Purpose:
Recently, car audio systems have rapidly developed
and the functions have vastly changed. The
conventional car audio system is being integrated
with multi-media interfaces similar to those in
navigation systems. At the same time, customers
are demanding higher quality from their audio
systems. This is merely an overview of the
standardization background. The specific purposes
are as follows:
(1) To solve sound problems, etc. caused by using
components of different manufacturers through
signal standardization.
(2) To allow each manufacturer to concentrate on
developing products they do best. From this,
reasonably priced products can be produced.
HINT:
• If a short to +B or short to ground is detected
in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is
interrupted and the audio system will stop
functioning.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4.
5.
AV–9
• If an audio system is equipped with a
navigation system, the multi-display unit acts
as the master unit. If the navigation system is
not equipped, the audio head unit acts as the
master unit instead. If the radio and
navigation assembly is equipped, it is the
master unit.
• The radio receiver contains a resistor that is
necessary to enable communication on the
different AVC-LAN circuits.
• The car audio system with an AVC-LAN
circuit has a diagnostic function.
• Each component has a specified number (3digit) called a physical address. Each function
has a number (2-digit) called a logical
address.
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM OUTLINE
(a) Components of the audio system communicate with
each other via the AVC-LAN.
(b) The master component of the AVC-LAN is a radio
receiver with a 60 to 80 Ω resistor. This is essential
for communication.
(c) If a short circuit or open circuit occurs in the AVCLAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the
audio system will stop functioning.
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION OUTLINE
(a) The audio system has a diagnostic function (the
result is indicated on the master unit).
(b) A 3-digit hexadecimal component code (physical
address) is allocated to each component on the
AVC-LAN. Using this code, the component in the
diagnostic function can be displayed.
AV
AV–10
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check whether or not the radio receiver turns on.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Radio receiver turns on
A
Radio receiver does not turn on
B
B
Go to step 6
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTCs.
(c) Recheck for DTCs by simulating the operation indicated
by the DTCs.
HINT:
• If the system cannot enter the diagnosis mode,
inspect the AVC-LAN and all the components that
connect to the AVC-LAN for short circuits and repair
or replace the problem part.
• Even if the malfunction symptom is not confirmed,
check the DTCs. This is because the system stores
past DTCs.
• Check and clear past DTCs. Then check for DTCs.
AV
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output again
A
DTC is not output
B
AV–11
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
B
Go to step 6
A
5
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Find the output code on the diagnostic trouble code chart
(See page AV-27).
NEXT
Go to step 8
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Refer to the problem symptoms table (See page AV-13).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 8
A
7
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU (See page AV-15).
NEXT
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
9
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
AV
AV–49
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-DF
Master Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-DF
*1
The device with a display fails and the master is
switched to the audio device.
Also when a communication error between sub-master
(audio) and master occurs, this code is stored.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Radio receiver power source circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component which has stored this code
Radio receiver
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*1: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio receiver is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
Refer to the radio receiver power source circuit (See page
AV-146).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
AV
AV–50
2
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
TXM-
TXM+
E119766E04
OK
3
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
AV
AV–51
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Example:
(*1)
Service Check Mode
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
Detailed Information Mode
Component which has stored this code
(*3)
(*4)
Continues to display check result when
more components are installed.
(*1)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*2)
(*2)
(*1)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
DTC
Continues to display detailed information of
the first code.
(*1)
(*2)
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
(*1)
(*2)
E110915E04
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Component
Physical address
Stereo component amplifier
440
Television display assembly
1B0
HINT:
• "440 (stereo component amplifier)" is the component
which has stored this code in the example shown in the
illustration.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
AV
AV–52
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NEXT
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page AV-15).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio
receiver and the component which has stored this
code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
R1 ATX+
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
TX- S22
9
TXM+ R4
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
TXM+ R4
6 Speaker System:
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
AV
E119767E03
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
AV–53
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Replace the radio receiver with a normal one and check
if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
OK
END
AV
AV–54
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication Error
DTC
01-E3
Registration Demand Transmission
DTC
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-E0
"Registration complete" signal from the master device
cannot be received.
-
01-E3
The registration demand signal from the slave device is
output. Or the registration demand signal is output by
receiving connection confirmation signal from the submaster device.
-
01-E4
The multiple frame transmission is incomplete.
-
HINT:
Even if no fault is present, this a trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or engine
start voltage.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs. These DTCs do not indicate a malfunction.
AV
AV–55
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
01-E2
DTC Detection Condition
The command for ON/OFF control from the master
device has a problem.
Trouble Area
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
NEXT
END
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–1
AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
OBSERVE HANDLING AND OPERATIONAL
PRECAUTIONS
(a) Please explain to the customer that when the negative
terminal is disconnected from the battery, the channel
information memory of the AM/FM broadcast stations in the
radio receiver is cleaned. If necessary, make a note of the
recorded channel information before the negative terminal is
disconnected, then reset the information after the negative
terminal is reconnected.
(b) The removal/installation of the radio receiver should be
performed after all audio CDs are ejected from the radio
receiver.
HINT:
If audio CDs cannot be ejected due to the malfunction of the
radio receiver, do not try to drag them out by force. Bring the
vehicle to the repair plant.
(c) Fasten the earth bolt securely when the antenna cord is
removed or installed.
HINT:
Failing to fasten the earth bolt securely causes noise at the
time of radio wave reception.
(d) Do not touch the cone paper of the speaker.
AV
AV–2
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
- FRONT STEREO COMPONENT
SPEAKER
RADIO RECEIVER
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
- FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER RH
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (*2)
SPIRAL CABLE
STEREO JACK ADAPTER
WINDOW GLASS
ANTENNA WIRE
STEERING PAD SWITCH
ENGINE ROOM R/B
(*1)
REAR NO. 2
SPEAKER
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
- FRONT NO. 2
SPEAKER LH
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
- FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
REAR SPEAKER
- WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
*1: 10 Speaker System
*2: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
AV
E119756E01
AV–56
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-10
DVD Player Mechanical Error
DTC
44-11
DVD Insertion and Ejection Error
DTC
44-12
DVD Reading Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
44-10
A mechanical error in the DVD player is detected while
the DVD is not being inserted or ejected.
44-11
DVD insertion or ejection is failed.
44-12
DVD read problem occurs.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
AV
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
Trouble Area
Television display assembly
AV–57
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
44-42
Disc cannot be Read
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
44-41
An unsuitable disc is inserted.
44-42
The disc cannot be read.
Trouble Area
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
2
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
I100151
NEXT
3
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
AV
AV–58
4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
5
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
AV–59
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-43
DVD-ROM Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
44-43
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
DVD-ROM operation is abnormal.
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK IF A PROPER DVD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the DVD is a video DVD or a CD with an
MP3 file, and that it is not deformed, flawed, stained,
burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal DVD or CD
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped DVDs or CDs cannot
be played.
• For details on playable DVDs or CDs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
NG
END
OK
2
CHANGE DISC
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
AV
AV–60
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-44
DVD Error
DTC
44-48
Excess Current
DTC
44-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
44-44
Operation error in the DVD mechanism.
44-48
Excess current is present in the DVD player.
44-50
Malfunction in insertion / ejection system.
Trouble Area
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the television
display assembly.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
AV–61
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-45
Eject Error
DTC
44-51
Elevator Error
DTC
44-52
Clamp Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
44-45
Disc cannot be ejected.
44-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator operation.
44-52
Error occurs in DVD player clamp.
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Check if a disc can be changed, inserted or ejected
normally.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
AV
AV–62
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
44-46
Scratches or dirt is found on DVD surface or DVD is set
upside down.
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK THAT DISC IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check whether or not the disc is inserted upside down.
OK:
Disc is properly inserted.
NG
INSPECT DISC
OK
2
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
3
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
AV
I100151
NEXT
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–63
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
6
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
AV
AV–64
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-47
High Temperature
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
44-47
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Sensor detects that DVD unit temperature is high.
(Over 80°C)
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the television display
assembly becomes sufficiently low, and start the engine.
Check that the malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
AV–65
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-78
DSP Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
44-78
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
An error occurs during the decode process (MP3/
WMA).
-
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
NOTICE:
• This code may be output even if there is no malfunction.
• If this code is output frequently, replace the television display assembly.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
AV
AV–66
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
44-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
44-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
44-7F
Copyright Protection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
An incompatible MP3/WMA file is used.
Although the file has an extension of ".mp3" or
".wma", the header information cannot be read.
44-7E
•
•
A disc with no music data is used.
Playable files are not on the disc (MP3/WMA).
44-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
44-7D
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHANGE DISC
(a) Insert a disc with a playable file and check if the disc can
be played correctly.
HINT:
For details on playable files and discs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
OK:
The disc can be played correctly.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
AV–67
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-10
CD Player Mechanical Error
DTC
62-11
CD Insertion and Ejection Error
DTC
62-12
CD Reading Abnormal
DTC
63-10
CD Changer Mechanical Error
DTC
63-11
CD Insertion and Ejection Error
DTC
63-12
CD Reading Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
62-10
A mechanical error in the CD player is detected while
the CD is not being inserted or ejected.
62-11
CD insertion or ejection is failed.
62-12
CD read problem occurs.
63-10
A mechanical error in the CD changer is detected while
the CD is not being inserted or ejected.
63-11
CD insertion or ejection is failed.
63-12
CD read problem occurs.
Trouble Area
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
NEXT
END
AV
AV–68
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
62-42
Disc cannot be Read
DTC
63-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
63-42
Disc cannot be Read
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
62-41
An unsuitable disc is inserted.
62-42
The disc cannot be read.
63-41
An unsuitable disc is inserted.
63-42
The disc cannot be read.
Trouble Area
•
•
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
2
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
AV
I100151
NEXT
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3
AV–69
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
4
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
5
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
END
AV
AV–70
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
DTC
63-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
62-43
CD-ROM operation is abnormal
63-43
CD-ROM operation is abnormal
Trouble Area
•
•
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK IF A PROPER CD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the CD is an audio CD or a CD with an
MP3 or WMA file, and that it is not deformed, flawed,
stained, burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal CD
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped CDs cannot be
played.
• CDs with adhesive paper labels should not be played.
• Commercial audio CDs can be played.
• CD-DA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs can
be played.
• MP3 and WMA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CDRWs can be played.
• For details on playable CDs, refer to the Owner's
Manual.
NG
CHANGE DISC
OK
2
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the CD with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the CD with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
AV
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–71
OK
END
AV
AV–72
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-44
CD Abnormal
DTC
62-48
Excess Current
DTC
62-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DTC
63-44
CD Abnormal
DTC
63-48
Excess Current
DTC
63-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
62-44
Operation error in the CD mechanism
62-48
Excess current is present in the CD player
62-50
Malfunction in insertion/ejection system
63-44
Operation error in the CD mechanism
63-48
Excess current is present in the CD changer
63-50
Malfunction in insertion/ejection system
Trouble Area
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the radio
receiver.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
AV
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–73
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-45
Eject Error
DTC
62-51
Elevator Error
DTC
62-52
Clamp Error
DTC
63-45
Eject Error
DTC
63-51
Elevator Error
DTC
63-52
Clamp Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
62-45
Disc cannot be ejected.
62-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator operation.
62-52
Error occurs in CD player clamp.
63-45
Magazine cannot be ejected.
63-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator operation.
63-52
Error occurs in CD changer clamp.
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check if a disc can be changed, inserted or ejected
normally.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
END
AV
AV–12
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
IDENTIFICATION OF NOISE SOURCE
1.
Frequency
300 kHz
30 kHz
Designation
Radio Description
(a) Radio frequency band
(1) Radio broadcasts use the radio frequency bands
shown in the table below.
LF
MF
Modulation
HF
VHF
FM
Amplitude modulation
MF: Medium Frequency
300 MHz
30 MHz
AM
Radio Wave
LF: Low Frequency
30 MHz
HF: High Frequency
Frequency modulation
VHF: Very High Frequency
E108734E01
(b) Service area
(1) The service areas of AM and FM broadcasts are
vastly different. Sometimes an AM broadcast
can be received very clearly but an FM stereo
cannot. FM stereo has the smallest service area,
and is prone to pick up static and other types of
interference such as noise.
(c) Radio reception problems
HINT:
In addition to static, other problems such as
"phasing", "multipath", and "fade out" exist. These
problems are not caused by electrical noise, but by
the radio signal propagation method itself.
FM (Stereo)
FM (Monaural)
AM
E108735E01
Phasing
Ionosphere
I100011E02
AV
(1) Phasing
AM broadcasts are susceptible to electrical
interference and another kind of interference
called phasing. Occurring only at night, phasing
is the interference created when a vehicle
receives 2 radio wave signals from the same
transmitter. One signal is reflected off the
ionosphere and the other signal is received
directly from the transmitter.
AV–13
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(2) Multipath
Multipath is a type of interference created when
a vehicle receives 2 radio wave signals from the
same transmitter. One signal is reflected off
buildings or mountains and the other signal is
received directly from the transmitter.
Multipath
I100012E02
(3) Fade out
Fade out is caused by objects (buildings,
mountains, and other such large obstacles) that
deflect away part of a signal, resulting in a
weaker signal when the object is between the
transmitter and vehicle. High frequency radio
waves, such as FM broadcasts, are easily
deflected by obstructions. Low frequency radio
waves, such as AM broadcasts, are much more
difficult to deflect.
(d) Noise problem
Technicians must have a clear understanding about
each customer's noise complaint. Use the following
table to diagnose noise problems.
Fade Out
I100013E02
Radio Frequency
Noise Occurrence Condition
Presumable Cause
AM
Noise occurs in a specified area
Foreign noise
AM
Noise occurs when listening to an intermittent broadcast
An identical program transmitted from
multiple towers can cause noise where the
signals overlap
AM
Noise occurs only at night
Music beat from a distant broadcast
FM
Noise occurs while driving in a specified area
Multipath or phasing noise resulting from a
change in FM frequency
HINT:
If the noise does not match the examples above, refer to the
descriptions about phasing and multipath.
AV
AV–74
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
DTC
63-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
62-46
Scratches or dirt is found on CD surface or CD is set
upside down.
63-46
Scratches or dirt is found on CD surface or CD is set
upside down.
•
•
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK THAT CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check whether or not the CD is inserted upside down.
OK:
CD is properly inserted.
NG
REINSERT CD PROPERLY
OK
2
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
I100152
OK
AV
CHANGE DISC
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3
AV–75
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
I100151
NEXT
4
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
6
REINSERT CD PROPERLY
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
END
AV
AV–76
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-47
High Temperature
DTC
63-47
High Temperature
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
62-47
Sensor detects that CD unit temperature is high. (Over
80°C)
63-47
Sensor detects that CD unit temperature is high. (Over
80°C)
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the radio receiver
becomes sufficiently low, and start the engine. Check
that the malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–77
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-78
DSP Error
DTC
63-78
DSP Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
62-78
An error occurs during the decode process (MP3/
WMA).
-
63-78
An error occurs during the decode process (MP3/
WMA).
-
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
NOTICE:
• These codes may be output even if there is no malfunction.
• If these codes are output frequently, replace the radio receiver.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
END
AV
AV–150
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
- RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY (*2)
-FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
- RADIO RECEIVER (*1)
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
-FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER LH
-FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER RH
ENGINE ROOM R/B
TEREVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
VIDEO TERMINAL
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
-FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
REAR SPEAKER
REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER (*1)
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
-WOOFER BOX
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
AV
*1: without Navigation System
*2: with Navigation System
E119737E01
AV–151
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver (*1)
Radio and Navigation
Assembly (*2)
Stereo Component Amplifier
Speakers
(*2)
Television Display Assembly
Remote Controller
Wireless Headphone
Video Terminal
: Display Signal
*1: without Navigation System
*2: with Navigaiton System
: Sound Signal
: AVC-LAN
E119738E01
AV
AV–78
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
62-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
62-7F
Copyright Protection Error
DTC
63-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
63-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
63-7F
Copyright Protection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
An incompatible MP3/WMA file is used.
Although the file has an extension of ".mp3" or
".wma", the header information cannot be read.
62-7E
•
•
A disc with no music data is used.
Playable files are not on the disc (MP3/WMA).
62-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
63-7D
•
•
An incompatible MP3/WMA file is used
Although the file has an extension of ".mp3" or
".wma", the header information cannot be read.
63-7E
•
•
A disc with no music data is used.
Playable files are not on the disc (MP3/WMA).
63-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
62-7D
•
•
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHANGE DISC
(a) Insert a disc with a playable file and check if the disc can
be played correctly.
HINT:
For details on playable files and discs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
OK:
The disc can be played correctly.
NG
OK
AV
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–79
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Noise Occurs
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
NOISE CONDITION
(a) Check in which direction the noise comes from (front left
or right, or rear left or right).
(1) Check in which direction the noise comes from.
OK:
The location of the noise source can be
determined.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
CHECK SPEAKERS
(a) Check the installation conditions of the speaker units that
are located near the noise source and that there are no
cracks, scratches, deformation, or other failures.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
A speaker is installed incorrectly
A
Foreign objects are in the speaker
B
A speaker cone paper is broken
C
No malfunction is found
D
A
REINSTALL SPEAKER
B
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT
C
REPLACE SPEAKER
D
3
CHECK NOISE CONDITIONS
(a) Check the noise condition.
HINT:
The radio has a noise prevention function to reduce
noise when listening to the radio. If a loud noise occurs,
check whether the ground at the antenna mounting base
and the noise prevention unit are installed and wired
correctly.
Conditions under which noise occurs
Noise Source
Noise increases when the accelerator pedal is depressed, but stops when the engine is stopped.
Generator
Noise occurs during A/C or heater operation.
Noise occurs when the vehicle accelerates rapidly on an unpaved road or after the ignition switch
is turned ON or ACC.
Blower motor
Fuel pump
AV
AV–80
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Conditions under which noise occurs
Noise Source
Noise occurs when the horn switch is pressed and released or when pressed and held.
Horn
Noise occurs synchronously with the blink of the turn signal.
Flasher
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Washer
Noise occurs while the engine is running, and continues even after the engine is stopped.
Noise occurs during wiper operation.
Water temperature sensor
Wiper
Noise occurs when the brake pedal is depressed.
Stop light switch
Others
Static electricity
HINT:
• In the chart's left column, find the situation that
matches the customer's complaint. Then, in the right
column, find the part that is causing the noise. Check
the noise filter on or for the part.
• To save time and avoid a misdiagnosis, first make
sure that the noise is not coming from outside the
vehicle.
• Noise should be removed in descending order of
loudness.
• Setting the radio to a frequency where no signal is
received may make recognition of the noise problem
easier.
OK:
The noise source can not be determined.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NOISE SOURCE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–81
Pressing Power Switch does not Turn on System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
(a) Check that conditions in the cabin are not likely to cause
condensation.
HINT:
This problem occurs when the cabin is humid and the
temperature changes rapidly. This may produce
condensation, resulting in a short circuit.
OK:
Condensation is not likely to be produced.
NG
DRY OUT CABIN AND RECHECK
CONDITION
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–82
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
No Sound can be Heard from Speakers
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check radio receiver setting.
(1) Check that the volume is not set to "0".
(2) Check that "MUTE" is off.
OK:
The volume is not set to "0" and "MUTE" is off.
OK
END
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–83
Sound Quality is Bad Only when CD is Played (Volume is Too Low)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the CD with another one and recheck.
(1) Check if the problem recurs using another CD.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
END
AV
AV–84
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CD cannot be Ejected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Press the CD EJECT switch of the radio receiver for 2
seconds or more and check that the CD is ejected.
OK:
CD is ejected.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
2
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Insert another CD and check if it is ejected.
OK:
CD is ejected.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–85
CD cannot be Inserted / Played or CD is Ejected Right After Insertion
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK IF A PROPER CD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the CD is an audio CD or a CD with an
MP3 or WMA file, and that it is not deformed, flawed,
stained, burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal CD.
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped CDs cannot be
played.
• CDs with adhesive paper labels should not be played.
• Commercial audio CDs can be played.
• CD-DA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs can
be played.
• MP3 and WMA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CDRWs can be played.
• For details on playable CDs, refer to the Owner's
Manual.
NG
CHANGE DISC
OK
2
CHECK THAT CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check whether or not the CD is inserted upside down.
OK:
CD is properly inserted.
NG
REINSERT CD PROPERLY
OK
3
CHECK CD
(a) Clean the disc by wiping it with a soft cloth from the
inside to the outside in a radial direction.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
NG
I100151
Go to step 4
AV
AV–86
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
END
4
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the CD with a normal one and check that the
malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–87
CD Sound Skips
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CD
(a) Check the CD.
OK:
The CD is clean.
HINT:
If dirt is on the CD surface, wipe it clean with a soft cloth
from the inside to the outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100151
NG
CLEAN CD
OK
2
CHECK CD
(a) Check that the CD is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the CD.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION USING ANOTHER CD
(a) Check using another CD.
(1) Check if the problem recurs using another CD.
OK:
The problem does not occur.
OK
END
NG
4
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check the radio receiver installation condition.
(1) Check that the radio receiver is properly installed.
OK:
Radio receiver is properly installed.
AV
AV–88
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
REINSTALL RADIO RECEIVER PROPERLY
AV–89
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Radio Broadcast cannot be Received or Poor Reception
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check the radio's automatic station search function.
(1) Check the radio's automatic station search function
by activating it.
OK:
The radio's automatic station search function
works properly.
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
NG
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
Wire Harness View (10 Speaker System):
R1
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R1 or R2.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ANT - Body ground
Ignition SW ON
Radio SW ON
10 to 14 V
NG
ANT
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
Wire Harness View (6 Speaker System):
R2
ANT
AV
E120110E01
AV–90
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK OPTIONAL COMPONENTS
(a) Check optional components (sun-shade film, telephone
antenna, etc.).
(1) Check if any optional components, such as
sunshade film or telephone antenna that may
decrease reception capacity, are installed.
OK:
Optional components are installed.
NOTICE:
Do not remove any optional components
installed by the customer without his or her
consent.
OK
REMOVE OPTIONAL COMPONENTS AND
CHECK AGAIN (SEE NOTICE ABOVE)
NG
4
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
E050367
(a) Preparation for check
(1) Remove the antenna plug from the radio receiver.
(b) Check for noise
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position with the
radio receiver connector connected.
(2) Turn the radio on and put into AM mode.
(3) Place a screwdriver, thin wire, or other metal object
on the radio receiver's antenna jack and check that
noise can be heard from the speaker.
OK:
Noise occurs.
NG
OK
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
5
AV–91
CHECK GLASS ANTENNA
(a) Check for continuity of the antenna.
HINT:
Check for continuity at the center of each antenna wire
as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, wipe it in the direction of
the wire with a soft dry cloth. Take care not to
damage the wire. Do not use detergents or glass
cleaners with abrasive ingredients. When measuring
voltage, wrap a piece of tin foil around the tip of the
negative probe and press the foil against the wire
with your finger, as shown in the illustration.
OK:
There is continuity in the antenna.
Tester Probe
Tin Foil
Antenna Wire
NG
REPAIR GLASS ANTENNA
E111994E01
OK
6
CHECK ANTENNA CORD
(a) Remove the antenna plug of the radio receiver and
antenna.
(b) Measure the resistance between the antenna and radio
receiver to check for an open circuit in the antenna cord.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the resistance between the antenna cord and
body ground to check for a short circuit in the antenna
cord.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE ANTENNA CORD
OK
7
REPLACE AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
(a) Replace the amplifier antenna and check if radio
broadcasts can be received normally.
OK:
Radio broadcasts can be received.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
AV
AV–92
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–93
Poor Sound Quality in All Modes (Low Volume)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUDIO SETTINGS
(a) Set "BASS", "MID", and "TREB" to the initial values and
check that sound is normal.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
2
COMPARE WITH ANOTHER VEHICLE OF SAME MODEL
(a) Compare with another vehicle of the same model.
(1) Compare with another vehicle of the same model
which does not have trouble to see if there is any
difference in the sound quality.
OK:
No difference is found.
OK
END
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–94
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Combination
Meter
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is necessary for the ASL (Auto Sound Leveliser) built into the radio receiver.
Speed signals are received from the combination meter and used for the ASL.
The ASL function automatically adjusts the sound data in order to enable hearing the clear audio sound
even when vehicle noise increases (as vehicle noise increases, the volume is turned up etc.).
HINT:
• A voltage of 12 V or 5 V is output from each ECU and then input to the combination meter. The signal
is changed to a pulse signal at the transistor in the combination meter. Each ECU controls the
respective system based on the pulse signal.
• If a short occurs in an ECU, all systems in the diagram below will not operate normally.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver
3
R5
From A/C Control
Assembly
From Moon Roof
Control ECU
SPD
From ECM
From 4WD Control ECU
From Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
5
C9
From Main Body ECU
Combination Meter
From Speed Sensor
E120038E01
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–95
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer on the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on the
speedometer are the same.
HINT:
the vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when the
indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
CHECK COMBINATION METER
OK
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R5.
(b) Measure the voltage.
(1) Jack up either one of the drive wheels.
(2) Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Radio Receiver
Wire Harness View:
R5
SPD
E120042E03
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the
radio receiver and body ground when the drive
wheels are turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage pulses as shown in the illustration.
OK
4.5 to 14 V
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
Below 2 V
0
Turn the wheel
E110855E03
NG
AV
AV–96
3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R5 and
combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Wire Harness View:
R5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD - C9-5
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
NG
SPD
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C9-5
E120043E01
OK
AV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV–97
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R5 and
combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Wire Harness View:
R5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD - Body ground
Ignition switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the resistance between terminal SPD and body ground
is less than 10 kΩ, there may be a short in a wire
harness, connector, or an ECU that is connected to the
SPD signal wire.
SPD
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR OR EACH ECU
C9-5
E120043E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
AV
AV–98
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Steering Pad Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends an operation signal from the steering pad switch to the radio receiver.
If there is an open in the circuit, the audio system cannot be operated using the steering pad switch.
If there is a short in the circuit, the same condition as that when the switch is continuously depressed
occurs.
Therefore, the radio receiver cannot be operated using the steering pad switch, and also the radio
receiver itself cannot function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Pad SW LH
Spiral Cable
12
A
Volume-
Volume+
Seek-
12
AU1
C13
Radio Receiver
7
R5 SW1
Seek+
10
A
EAU
11
A
AU2
10
C13
6
R5 SWG
MODE
11
C13
8
R5 SW2
E110885E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) which includes
components such as airbags. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure
to read the precautionary notice for the Supplemental Restraint System (See page RS-1).
AV
AV–99
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
Wire Harness View (10 Speaker System):
R5
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R5.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SW1 - SWG
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
SW1 - SWG
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
SW1 - SWG
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
SW1 - SWG
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
SW1 - SWG
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
SW2 - SWG
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
SW2 - SWG
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
SW2
NG
SW1
Go to step 2
SWG
Wire Harness View (6 Speaker System):
R5
SW2
SW1
SWG
E120024E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
2
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch LH connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
AV
AV–100
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
A
AU1
EAU
AU2
I039169E04
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
AU1 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU1 - EAU
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
NG
OK
AV
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
AV–101
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch and spiral cable
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side:
A
EAU AU2 AU1
Tester Connection
Spiral Cable Position
EAU - EAU
2.5 rotations to the left
Specified Condition
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Center
AU1 - AU1
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Center
AU2 - AU2
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Vehicle Side:
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS
airbag system. Incorrect removal or installation of
the spiral cable may prevent the airbag from
deploying. Be sure to read the page shown in the
brackets (See page RS-398).
NG
EAU AU2 AU1
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
C13
E113447E07
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO RECEIVER)
AV
AV–14
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
• Before inspecting the suspected areas listed in the table
below, check the fuse and relay.
• Before inspecting the suspected areas listed in the table
below, check for DTCs.
• Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed
in order of probability in the suspected area column.
Audio Function:
Symptom
Pressing power switch does not turn on system.
Panel switch does not function.
No sound be heard from speakers. (Audio is mute.)
(10 speaker system)
No sound be heard from speakers. (Audio is mute.) (6
speaker system)
Sound quality is bad in all modes. (Volume is too low.)
(10 speaker system)
AV
Sound quality is bad in all modes. (Volume is too low.)
(6 speaker system)
ASL does not function. (10 speaker system)
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Pressing Power Switch does not Turn on
System"
AV-80
2. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
3. AVC-LAN circuit
AV-128
4. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Steering pad switch circuit
AV-97
2. AVC-LAN circuit
AV-128
3. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
2. Proceed to "No Sound can be Heard from Speakers"
AV-81
3. Stereo component amplifier power source circuit
AV-148
4. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-116
5. Speaker circuit
AV-108
6. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-123
7. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Television Display Assembly" (*1)
AV-125
8. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
9. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
2. Proceed to "No Sound can be Heard from Speakers"
AV-81
3. Speaker circuit
AV-108
4. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Television Display Assembly" (*1)
AV-125
5. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Proceed to "Poor Sound Quality in All Modes (Low Volume)"
AV-92
2. Speaker circuit.
AV-108
3. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-116
4. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-123
5. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Television Display Assembly" (*1)
AV-125
6. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
7. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Proceed to "Poor Sound Quality in All Modes (Low Volume)"
AV-92
2. Speaker circuit
AV-108
3. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Television Display Assembly" (*1)
AV-125
4. Radio receiver
AV-167
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Stereo
Component Amplifier and Combination Meter"
AV-130
AV–15
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Symptom
ASL does not function. (6 speaker system)
RSE sound cannot be heard or sound quality is bad.
(*1)
External device sound cannot be heard or sound
quality is bad. (Stereo jack is used.)
Abnormal noise occurs. (10 speaker system)
Abnormal noise occurs. (6 speaker system)
Radio broadcast cannot be received or poor reception.
CD cannot be inserted/played or CD is ejected right
after insertion.
CD cannot be ejected.
Suspected area
See page
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio
Receiver and Combination Meter"
AV-93
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
2. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
3. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Television Display Assembly"
AV-118
4. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Television Display Assembly"
AV-125
5. Radio receiver
AV-167
6. Television display assembly
AV-177
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
2. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Jack Adapter"
AV-121
3. Stereo jack adapter
AV-191
4. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Proceed to "Noise occurs"
AV-78
2. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
3. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Proceed to "Noise occurs"
AV-78
2. Radio receiver
AV-167
Proceed to "Radio Broadcast cannot be Received or Poor
Reception"
AV-88
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
2. Proceed to "CD cannot be Inserted/Played or CD is Ejected
Right After Insertion"
AV-84
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-146
2. Proceed to "CD cannot be Ejected"
AV-83
Sound quality is bad only when CD is played. (Volume
is too low.)
Proceed to "Sound Quality is Bad Only when CD is Played
(Volume is Too Low)"
AV-82
CD sound skips.
Proceed to "CD Sound Skips"
AV-86
1. Illumination circuit
AV-101
2. Radio receiver
AV-167
Radio receiver cannot be illuminated at night.
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
Steering Pad Switch Function:
Symptom
Audio system cannot be operated with steering pad
switch.
Steering pad switch cannot be illuminated at night.
Suspected area
See page
1. Steering pad switch circuit
AV-97
2. Radio receiver
AV-167
1. Illumination circuit
AV-101
2. Radio receiver
AV-167
AV
AV–102
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Illumination Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Power is supplied to the radio receiver and steering pad switch illumination when the light control switch is
in the TAIL or HEAD position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Pad SW
Spiral Cable
1
10
ILL+
EAU
Radio Receiver
10
R2
(*1)
1
10
2
R1
ILL+
(*2)
6
R5
SWG
12
R1
ILL-
TAIL Relay
TAIL
From J/B Fuse
To Main Body ECU
R13 Rheostat
5
E
-
3
5
R3
(*1)
(*2)
*1: 6 Speaker System
*2: 10 Speaker System
E120025E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
AV
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) which includes
components such as airbags. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure
to read the precautionary notice for the supplemental restraint system (See page RS-1).
AV–103
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
1
CHECK ILLUMINATION
(a) Check if the illumination for the radio receiver, steering
pad switch, glove box or others (hazard switch, cigarette
lighter, etc.) comes on when the light control switch is
turned to the HEAD or TAIL position.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Illumination comes on for all components except steering pad switch.
A
Illumination comes on for all components except radio receiver.
B
No illumination comes on (radio receiver, hazard switch, glove box, etc.).
C
Illumination comes on only for glove box and steering pad switch.
D
B
Go to step 6
C
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
D
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - SPIRAL CABLE)
Spiral Cable Connector Front View:
(a) Disconnect the spiral cable connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ILL+ - Body ground
Light control SW TAIL
or HEAD
10 to 14 V
ILL+
NG
E121218E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch connector.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal ILL+ and the
negative (-) lead to terminal EAU of the steering pad
switch connector.
AV
AV–104
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Connector Front View:
A
E120027E01
(c) Check if the illumination for the steering pad switch
comes on.
OK:
Illumination for the steering pad switch comes on.
NG
OK
AV
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–105
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch and and spiral cable
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side:
ILL+
EAU
Tester Connection
Spiral Cable Position
EAU - EAU
2.5 rotations to the left
Specified Condition
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Center
ILL+ - ILL+
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS
airbag system. Incorrect removal or installation of
the spiral cable may prevent the airbag from
deploying. Be sure to read the page shown in the
brackets (See page RS-398).
Vehicle Side:
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
EAU
ILL+
E113447E06
OK
AV
AV–106
5
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO RECEIVER)
Radio Receiver (10 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R5
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver and
spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
SWG - EAU
Always
Below 1 Ω
SWG - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
SWG
Radio Receiver (6 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R5
SWG
Spiral Cable
Connector Front View:
EAU
E120029E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–107
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - RADIO RECEIVER)
Wire Harness View (10 Speaker System):
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R1 or R2.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ILL+ - Body ground
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
R1
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ILL+
Wire Harness View (6 Speaker System):
R2
ILL+
E120030E03
OK
AV
AV–108
7
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT)
Radio Receiver (10 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R1
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector and light control
rhepstat connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
ILL- - R13-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
ILL- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ILLRadio Receiver (6 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R3
ILLLight Control Rheostat
Wire Harness View:
R13
R13-3
E120031E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–109
Speaker Circuit
DESCRIPTION
• When the vehicle has a built-in type amplifier, a sound signal is sent from the radio receiver to the
speakers via the "6 Speaker System" circuit.
• When the vehicle has a separate type amplifier, a sound signal from the radio receiver is amplified by
the stereo component amplifier and then transmitted to the speaker via the "10 Speaker System"
circuit.
If there is a short in this circuit, the stereo component amplifier detects it and stops output to the speakers.
Thus sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no malfunction in the stereo component
amplifier or speakers.
AV
AV–110
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
6 Speaker System:
S20
Front No. 2 Speaker LH
2
D22
Front No. 1
Speaker LH
4
1
Radio Receiver
2
R2
FL+
6
2
1
3
R2
FL-
S21
Front No. 2 Speaker RH
2
D23
Front No. 1
Speaker RH
4
1
1
R2
FR+
5
2
1
3
R2
FR-
2
1
R16
Rear Speaker LH
R3
RL+
6
2
R3
RL-
1
1
R17
Rear Speaker RH
R3
RR+
5
2
R3
RR-
E121225E02
AV
AV–111
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
10 Speaker System:
Stereo Component Amplifier
1
4
S23 RL+
2
13
S23 RL-
1
5
S23 RR+
2
14
S23 RR-
R16
Rear Speaker LH
R17
Rear Speaker RH
Woofer Box Speaker
2
WF+ W4
8
S23 WFL+
4
WF-
19
S23 WFL-
W4
9
S23 WFR+
1
WF+ W4
3
20
S23 WFR-
WF- W4
4
4
R19
Rear No. 2
Speaker LH
2
S23 DRS+
R20
Rear No. 2
Speaker RH
3
11
S23 DRS-
3
E119760E03
AV
AV–112
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
C5
Front Stereo Component Speaker
3
3
S23 CTR+
12
4
S23 CTR-
S21
Front No. 2 Speaker RH
2
4
1
3
7
S23 FR+
1
D23
Front No. 1
Speaker RH
2
18
S23 FR-
S20
Front No. 2 Speaker LH
2
4
1
3
6
S23 FL+
1
D22
Front No. 1
Speaker LH
2
17
S23 FL-
E120023E03
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–113
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
Stereo Component Amplifier (10 Speaker
System) Wire Harness View:
FR+
WFL+
WFR+
FL+
RR+ RL+ CTR+
DRS+
S23
WFRWFLFR-
FL-
RR-
DRSCTRRL-
Radio Receiver (6 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R2
R3
FR+
RL+
FL+
RR+
FLRRRLFRFront No. 1 Speaker, Rear Speaker
Connector Front View:
D22
D23
R16
R17
Front No. 2 Speaker, Front
Stereo Component Speaker (*1)
Rear No. 2 Speaker (*1) Connector Front View:
R19 (*1)
R20 (*1)
S20
C5 (*1)
S21
*1: 10 Speaker System
E120041E01
(a) Disconnect the connectors shown in the illustration from
the stereo component amplifier or radio receiver and
speakers.
(b) 10 Speaker System:
Measure the resistance between each of the front No. 2
speakers and the stereo component amplifier to check
for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) 6 speaker System:
Measure the resistance between each of the front No. 2
speakers and the radio receiver to check for an open
circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(d) Measure the resistance between each of the front No. 2
speakers and each of the front No. 1 speakers to check
for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(e) 10 Speaker System:
Measure the resistance between each of the rear
speakers and the stereo component amplifier to check
for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(f) 6 Speaker System:
Measure the resistance between each of the rear
speakers and the radio receiver to check for an open
circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(g) 10 Speaker System:
Measure the resistance between each of the rear No. 2
speakers and the stereo component amplifier to check
for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(h) 10 Speaker System:
Measure the resistance between the front stereo
component speaker and the stereo component amplifier
to check for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
AV
AV–114
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(i)
Woofer Box Speaker Connector Front View:
W4
(j)
E120044E02
10 Speaker System:
Measure the resistance between the woofer box speaker
and the stereo component amplifier to check for an open
circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance between the each speaker and
body ground to check for a short circuit in the wire
harness.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the speaker.
Standard resistance:
10 Speaker System:
4 to 6 Ω
6 Speaker System:
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
OK
3
INSPECT REAR SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the speaker.
10 Speaker System:
Approximately 2.4 Ω
6 Speaker System:
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEAKER
OK
4
AV
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when another
speaker in good condition is installed.
Standard:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the front No. 2 speaker.
AV–115
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
front speaker is detective, inspect by interchanging
the right one with the left one.
• Perform the above inspection on both LH and RH
sides.
OK
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
NG
5
CONFIRM MODEL
Result
Result
Proceed to
10 Speaker System
A
6 Speaker System
B
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
6
INSPECT WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for
checking.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-3
Always
Approximately 1.2 Ω
2-4
Always
Approximately 1.2 Ω
E120044
NG
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
OK
7
INSPECT REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when another
speaker in good condition is installed.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the rear No. 2 speaker.
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left rear
speaker is detective, inspect by interchanging the right one
with the left one.
OK
REPLACE REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV
AV–116
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
8
INSPECT FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the speaker.
Standard resistance:
1.2 to 2.2 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT
SPEAKER
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–166
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
RADIO RECEIVER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY W/ BRACKET
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER
CONSOLE UPPER REAR
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
RADIO RECEIVER
RADIO NO. 1 BRACKET
AV
RADIO NO. 2 BRACKET
E115638E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
AV–167
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE (See
page IP-6)
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-8)
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
6.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-7)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER (See page IP-8)
8.
REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER (w/ Bracket)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Disconnect the connectors and remove the radio
receiver assembly with bracket.
9.
REMOVE RADIO NO. 1 BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 screws and radio No. 1 bracket.
E115642
I033306
10. REMOVE RADIO NO. 2 BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 screws and radio No. 2 bracket.
I033040
AV
AV–117
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Stereo Component
Amplifier
DESCRIPTION
The radio receiver sends a sound signal to the stereo component amplifier through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier, and then is sent to
the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
6
Radio Receiver
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
10
SLD
S22
2
19
L-
S22
R1
L-
L+
3
S22
9
R1
L+
R-
4
S22
18
R1
R-
5
8
R+ S22
R1
R1
SLD
R+
E120032E03
AV
AV–118
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver and
stereo component amplifier.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Wire Harness View:
R1
L+
SLD
L-
R+
R-
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
L+ - L+
Always
Below 1 Ω
L- - L-
Always
Below 1 Ω
R+ - R+
Always
Below 1 Ω
R- - R-
Always
Below 1 Ω
SLD - SLD
Always
Below 1 Ω
L+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
L- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SLD - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
S22
NG
R-
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
L-
SLD
R+
L+
E120033E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–119
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Television Display
Assembly
DESCRIPTION
The television display assembly sends a sound signal to the radio receiver through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier or radio receiver
(built-in amplifier), and then is sent to the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier, radio receiver, or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display
Assembly
Radio Receiver
(Shielded)
27
CSLD
1
R4
CDR+
2
R4
R18
3
29
CDR-
R4
CDL+
4
R4
CDL-
5
R4
R18
SG1
28
R+
R18 R30
R18
L+
31
R18
L-
E120034E04
AV
AV–120
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - TELEVISION DISPLAY
ASSEMBLY)
Radio Receiver (10 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the television display
assembly and radio receiver.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
CDR+ - R+
Always
Below 1 Ω
R4
CDLCDL+
CSLD
CDR+
CDRRadio Receiver (6 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R4
CSLD
CDR+
CDRTelevision Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R18
LL+
OK
AV
SG1
R-
R+
E120035E05
Always
Below 1 Ω
Always
Below 1 Ω
CDL- - L-
Always
Below 1 Ω
CSLD - SG1
Always
Below 1 Ω
R- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
L+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
L- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SG1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
CDLCDL+
CDR- - RCDL+ - L+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
AV–121
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the television display assembly connector.
(b) Check the waveform according to the conditions shown
in the table below.
Wire Harness View:
R18
L-
L+ R- R+
E120036E05
Standard
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
R+ - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
R- - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
L+ - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
L- - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–122
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Stereo Jack Adapter
DESCRIPTION
The stereo jack adapter sends an external device sound signal to the radio receiver through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier or radio receiver, and
then is sent to the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier, radio receiver, or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Jack Adapter
Radio Receiver
19
R5
AUXI
16
R5
ASGN
2
ARO S31
15
R5
ARI
1
ALO S31
17
R5
ALI
4
AUXO S31
3
ASGN S31
(Shielded)
E121224E02
AV
AV–123
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - STEREO JACK ADAPTER)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the stereo jack adapter
and radio receiver.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
Radio Receiver (10 Speaker System)
R5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
AUXO - AUXI
Always
Below 1 Ω
ASGN - ASGN
Always
Below 1 Ω
ARO - ARI
Always
Below 1 Ω
ALO - ALI
Always
Below 1 Ω
ASGN
AUXO - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AUXI
ASGN - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ARO - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ALO - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ALI
ARI
Wire Harness View:
Radio Receiver (6 Speaker System)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R5
ASGN
AUXI
ARI
ALI
Connector Front View:
Stereo Jack Adapter
S31
AUXO
ALO
ARO
ASGN
E124113E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–124
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Stereo Component
Amplifier
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the stereo component amplifier to mute noise. Because of that, the noise
produced by changing the sound source ceases.
If there is an open in the circuit, noise can be heard from the speakers when changing the sound source.
If there is a short in the circuit, even though the stereo component amplifier is normal, no sound, or only
an extremely small sound, can be produced.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
Radio Receiver
1
MUTE
7
R1 MUTE
S22
E110892E16
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
S22
MUTE
AV
Condition
Specified Condition
MUTE - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC, Audio system is
playing → Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
OK
E120037E02
NG
Tester Connection
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–125
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R1 and stereo
component amplifier connector S22.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Wire Harness View:
R1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
MUTE - MUTE
Always
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
MUTE
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
MUTE
E120033E04
OK
3
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (BUILT-IN STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Replace the stereo component amplifier and check if the
audio system operates normally.
OK:
The audio system operates normally.
OK
END
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–126
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Television Display
Assembly
DESCRIPTION
The radio receiver controls the volume according to the MUTE signal from the television display
assembly.
The MUTE signal is sent to reduce noise and a popping sound generated when switching the mode, etc.
If there is an open in the circuit, noise can be heard from the speakers when changing the sound source.
If there is a short in the circuit, even though the radio receiver is normal, no sound or, only an extremely
small sound, can be produced.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display Assembly
Radio Receiver
26
6
R4 MUTE
LMUT R18
E110892E17
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
R18
LMUT
AV
E120036E06
NG
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
LMUT - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC, RSE system is
playing → Changing
mode
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–127
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - TELEVISION DISPLAY)
Radio Receiver (10 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R4 and
television display assembly connector R18.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
R4
Condition
Specified Condition
MUTE - LMUT
Always
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
MUTE
Radio Receiver (6 Speaker System)
Wire Harness View:
R4
MUTE
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R18
LMUT
E120035E06
OK
3
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the television display assembly and check if the
audio system operates normally.
OK:
The audio system operates normally.
OK
END
AV
AV–128
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–129
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the audio system connected to the AVC-LAN (communication bus) transfers the signal of
each switch by communication.
When a short to +B or short to ground occurs in this AVC-LAN, the audio system will not function normally
as the communication is discontinued.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
TXM-
TXM+
E119766E04
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page AV-15).
AV
AV–130
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
all AVC-LAN circuits.
(1) Disconnect all connectors in all AVC-LAN circuits.
(2) Check for an open or short in all AVC-LAN circuits.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
TXM+ R4
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
TX- S22
9
R1 ATX+
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
6 Speaker System:
TXM+ R4
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
E119767E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–131
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Stereo Component Amplifier and
Combination Meter
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is necessary for the ASL (Auto Sound Leveliser) built into the stereo component amplifier.
Speed signals are received from the combination meter and used for the ASL.
The ASL function automatically adjusts the sound data in order to enable hearing the clear audio sound
even when vehicle noise increases (as vehicle noise increases, the volume is turned up etc.).
HINT:
• A voltage of 12 V or 5 V is output from each ECU and then input to the combination meter. The signal
is changed to a pulse signal at the transistor in the combination meter. Each ECU controls the
respective system based on the pulse signal.
• If a short occurs in an ECU, all systems in the diagram below will not operate normally.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
11
S22 SPD
From A/C Control
Assembly
From Moon Roof
Control ECU
From ECM
From 4WD Control ECU
From Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
5
C9
From Main Body ECU
Combination Meter
From Speed Sensor
E120038E04
AV
AV–132
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer on the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
CHECK COMBINATION METER
OK
2
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connector
S22.
(b) Measure the voltage.
(1) Jack up either one of the drive wheels.
(2) Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
SPD
E120039E02
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the
stereo component amplifier and body ground when
the drive wheels are turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage pulses as shown in the illustration.
NG
4.5 to 14 V
Below 2 V
0
AV
Turn the wheel
E110855E01
Go to step 3
AV–133
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (BUILT- IN STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connector
S22 and combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD - C9-5
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
NG
SPD
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C9-5
E120040E01
OK
AV
AV–134
4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connector
S22 and combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
SPD
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C9-5
E120040E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
AV
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD - Body ground
Ignition switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the resistance between terminal SPD and body ground
is less than 10 kΩ, there may be a short in a wire
harness, connector, or an ECU that is connected to the
SPD signal wire.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR OR CHECK EACH ECU
AV–135
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Radio Receiver Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
Example:
Service Check Mode
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
Detailed Information Mode
*3
*4
Continues to display check result when more
components are installed.
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*2
*1
*1
*2
*1
*1
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2
DTC
Component
shown by the
sub-code
Continues to display detailed information
of the first code.
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
*1
*2
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*1
*2
E110917E05
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "190 (radio receiver)" is the component shown by the subcode in the example shown in the illustration.
AV
AV–136
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (See page AV-148)
Television display assembly (1B0)
Television display assembly power source circuit (See page AV-163)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
AV
TXM-
TXM+
E119766E04
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–137
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - COMPONENT SHOWN BY
SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (See page AV-15).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio
receiver and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
TXM+ R4
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
TX- S22
9
R1 ATX+
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
TXM+ R4
6 Speaker System:
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
AV
E119767E03
AV–138
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–16
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
RADIO RECEIVER (10 SPEAKER SYSTEM)
R1
R5
R4
I035641E08
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
B (R1-1) - GND (R1-20)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
L-Y - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
ILL+ (R1-2) - GND (R1-20)
G - BR
Illumination signal
Light control switch OFF
→ TAIL
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
ATX+ (R1-5) - GND (R1-20)
B - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
MUTE (R1-7) - GND (R1-20)
W-R - BR
MUTE signal
Audio system is playing →
Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1 V
R+ (R1-8) - GND (R1-20)
B - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
L+ (R1-9) - GND (R1-20)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
SLD (R1-10) - Body ground
Shielded - Body
ground
Shield ground
Always
Below 1 V
ACC (R1-11) - GND (R1-20)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
10 to14 V
ILL- (R1-12) - GND (R1-20)
W-G - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Light control switch OFF
→ TAIL
Below 1 V → Pulse
generation
ANT (R1-13) - GND (R1-20)
B - BR
Power source of antenna
Radio switch ON and AM
or FM
10 to 14 V
ATX- (R1-15) - GND (R1-20)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
R- (R1-18) - GND (R1-20)
W - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
L- (R1-19) - GND (R1-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
GND (R1-20) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
W-R - BR
Steering pad switch
ground
Always
Below 1 V
4 V or more
→ Approx. 0.5 V
→ Approx. 0.9 V
→ Approx. 2.0 V
→ Approx. 3.4 V
SWG (R5-6) - GND (R1-20)
AV
SW1 (R5-7) - GND (R1-20)
V-W - BR
Steering pad switch signal
Steering pad switch not
operated
→ SEEK+ switch pushed
→ SEEK- switch pushed
→ VOL+ switch pushed
→ VOL- switch pushed
SW2 (R5-8) - GND (R1-20)
Y-B - BR
Steering pad switch signal
Steering pad switch not
operated → MODE switch
pushed
4 V or more → Below 2.5
V
ARI (R5-15) - GND (R1-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Right)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
ASGN (R5-16) - GND (R1-20)
Shielded - BR
Shield ground
Always
Below 1 V
Sound signal (Left)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
ALI (R5-17) - GND (R1-20)
R - BR
AV–17
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
AUXI (R5-19) - GND (R1-20)
L - BR
External device
connection detection
signal
External device is
connected
Below 1 V
CSLD (R4-1) - Body ground (*1)
Shielded - Body
ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
CDR+ (R4-2) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
B - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CDR- (R4-3) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
W - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CDL+ (R4-4) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
R - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CDL- (R4-5) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
G - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
MUTE (R4-6) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
V - BR
MUTE signal from RSE
RSE system is playing →
changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1 V
TXM+ (R4-9) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
R - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
TXM- (R4-10) - GND (R1-20) (*1)
G - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
2.
R2
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
RADIO RECEIVER (6 SPEAKER SYSTEM)
R3
R4
R5
E119761E03
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
FR+ (R2-1) - GND (R2-7)
LG - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FL+ (R2-2) - GND (R2-7)
P - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
ACC (R2-3) - GND (R2-7)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch OFF
→ ACC
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
+B (R2-4) - GND (R2-7)
L-Y - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
FR- (R2-5) - GND (R2-7)
L - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FL- (R2-6) - GND (R2-7)
V - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
GND (R2-7) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
ANT (R2-8) - GND (R2-7)
B - BR
Power source of antenna
Radio switch ON and AM
or FM
ILL+ (R2-10) - GND (R2-7)
G - BR
Illumination signal
Light control switch OFF
→ TAIL or HEAD
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
RR+ (R3-1) - GND (R2-7)
R - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RL+ (R3-2) - GND (R2-7)
B - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RR- (R3-3) - GND (R2-7)
W - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
AV
AV–18
Symbols (Terminal No.)
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
ILL- (R3-5) - GND (R2-7)
W-G - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Light control switch OFF
→ TAIL or HEAD
Below 1 V → Pulse
generation
RL- (R3-6) - GND (R2-7)
Y - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
SPD (R5-3) - GND (R2-7)
V-R - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
Turn ignition switch to ON.
Turn drive wheels slowly.
Pulse generation
SWG (R5-6) - GND (R2-7)
W-R - BR
Steering pad switch
ground
Always
Below 1 V
4 V or more
→ Approx. 0.5 V
→ Approx. 0.9 V
→ Approx. 2.0 V
→ Approx. 3.4 V
SW1 (R5-7) - GND (R2-7)
V-W - BR
Steering pad switch signal
Steering pad switch not
operated
→ SEEK+ switch pushed
→ SEEK- switch pushed
→ VOL+ switch pushed
→ VOL- switch pushed
SW2 (R5-8) - GND (R2-7)
Y-B - BR
Steering pad switch signal
Steering pad switch not
operated → MODE switch
pushed
4 V or more → Below 2.5
V
ARI (R5-15) - GND (R2-7)
G - BR
Sound signal (Right)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
ASGN (R5-16) - GND (R2-7)
Shielded - BR
Shield ground
Always
Below 1 V
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
ALI (R5-17) - GND (R2-7)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
AUXI (R5-19) - GND (R2-7)
L - BR
External device
connection detection
signal
External device is
connected
Below 1 V
CSLD (R4-1) - Body ground (*1)
Shielded - Body
ground
Shield ground
Always
Below 1 V
CDR+ (R4-2) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
B - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CDR- (R4-3) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
W - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CDL+ (R4-4) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
R - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CDL- (R4-5) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
G - BR
Sound signal from RSE
RSE system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
MUTE (R4-6) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
V - BR
MUTE signal from RSE
RSE system is playing →
changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1 V
TXM+ (R4-9) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
R - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
TXM- (R4-10) - GND (R2-7) (*1)
G - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
3.
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
S23
S22
AV
E120081E03
Symbols (Terminal No.)
MUTE (S22-1) - GND2 (S23-15)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
W-R - BR
Mute signal from radio
receiver
Audio system is playing →
Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1 V
AV–19
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
L- (S22-2) - GND2 (S23-15)
G - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
L+ (S22-3) - GND2 (S23-15)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
R- (S22-4) - GND2 (S23-15)
W - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
R+ (S22-5) - GND2 (S23-15)
B - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
SLD (S22-6) - Body ground
Shielded - Body
ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
TX- (S22-7) - GND2 (S23-15)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
TX+ (S22-8) - GND2 (S23-15)
B - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
SPD (S22-11) - GND2 (S23-15)
V-R - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
Turn ignition switch to ON.
Turn drive wheels slowly.
Pulse generation
ACC (S22-12) - GND2 (S23-15)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch OFF
→ ACC
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
+B (S23-1) - GND2 (S23-15)
W-L - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
DRS+ (S23-2) - GND2 (S23-15)
G-W - BR
Sound signal (Rear No. 2
Speaker)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
CTR+ (S23-3) - GND2 (S23-15)
G - BR
Sound signal (Front
Center)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RL+ (S23-4) - GND2 (S23-15)
B - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RR+ (S23-5) - GND2 (S23-15)
R - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FL+ (S23-6) - GND2 (S23-15)
P - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FR+ (S23-7) - GND2 (S23-15)
LG - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFL+ (S23-8) - GND2 (S23-15)
BR - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFR+ (S23-9) - GND2 (S23-15)
L-B - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
+B2 (S23-10) - GND2 (S23-15)
W-L - BR
Battery
Always
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
DRS- (S23-11) - GND2 (S23-15)
BR - BR
Sound signal (Rear No. 2
Speaker)
Audio system is playing
10 to 14 V
CTR- (S23-12) - GND2 (S23-15)
G-B - BR
Sound signal (Front
Center)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RL- (S23-13) - GND2 (S23-15)
Y - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RR- (S23-14) - GND2 (S23-15)
W - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
GND2 (S23-15) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
GND (S23-16) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
FL- (S23-17) - GND2 (S23-15)
V - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FR- (S23-18) - GND2 (S23-15)
L - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFL- (S23-19) - GND2 (S23-15)
G-W - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
L-R - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFR- (S23-20) - GND2 (S23-15)
4.
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page AV-155)
AV
AV–20
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
HINT:
If the system cannot enter the diagnostic mode, inspect all
AVC-LAN communication signals and repair or replace
problem parts. (See page AV-128)
1.
10 Speaker System:
SEEK TRACK
1
6
2.
DISC
6 Speaker System:
SEEK TRACK
1
DISC
STARTING DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(b) Turn off the audio system.
(c) While pressing the preset switches "1" and "6" at the
same time, press the "DISC" switch 3 times.
HINT:
A beep is emitted 3 times and the diagnostic
function is activated. The system enters the all
element illumination mode and the switch check
mode.
ALL ELEMENT ILLUMINATION MODE AND SWITCH
CHECK MODE
HINT:
Illumination status of all switches and operations of the
panel switches can be checked.
6
E119763E01
(a) Check that all elements are on.
(b) When pressing each panel switch, check that a
beep is emitted.
NOTICE:
Pressing the "SEEK TRACK UP" switch
transfers the screen to the stereo jack adapter
connection check screen. Check the operation
of this switch by confirming the transfer of the
screen.
Example:
E119764E02
AV
AV–21
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3.
When a stereo jack
adapter is connected:
When a stereo jack adapter
is not connected:
4.
E119765E02
5.
6.
STEREO JACK ADAPTER CONNECTION CHECK
MODE
(a) Press the "SEEK TRACK UP" switch.
(b) Check if the stereo jack adapter is recognized.
HINT:
Vehicles that do not have a stereo jack adapter also
have this function.
NOTICE:
This function is not to check connection
information on an external device, but to check
recognition information on a stereo jack
adapter.
SERVICE CHECK MODE
(a) Press the "SEEK TRACK UP" switch.
HINT:
For details of the service check mode, refer to "6.
CHECK DTC" and "7. DTC CLEAR/RECHECK".
FINISHING DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Press the "DISC" switch for 2 seconds or more, or
turn the ignition switch off.
CHECK DTC
HINT:
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
(a) Reference:
In the system check mode, the system check and
the diagnostic memory check are performed, and
the check results are displayed in ascending order
of the component codes (physical address).
Terms
Meaning
Component code
(Physical address)
Three-digit code (in hexadecimal) given to each device comprising AVC-LAN. Corresponding
to its function, individual symbol is provided.
Logical address
Two-digit code (in hexadecimal) given to each function and device unit in each device
comprising AVC-LAN.
(b) Service check result display
Display
good
nCon
ECHn
Previous term
Meaning
Action to be taken
Good (normal)
No DTCs are detected in both "System Check Mode" and "Diagnostic
Memory Mode".
-
No connection
Exchange
CHEC
Check
OLd
Old version
The system recognized the component when it was registered, but the
component gives no response to the "Diagnostic Mode ON Request".
Check the power source
circuit and the
communication circuit of
the component indicated
by the component code
(physical address).
One or more DTCs for "Exchange" are detected in either "System
Check Mode" or "Diagnostic Memory Mode".
Go to the detailed
information mode to check
the trouble area referring
to the DTC list.
When no DTCs are detected for "Exchange", one or more DTCs for
"Check" are detected in either "System Check Mode" or "Diagnostic
Memory Mode".
Go to the detailed
information mode to check
the trouble area referring
to the DTC list.
Old DTC application is identified and DTC is detected in either
"System Check Mode" or "Diagnostic Memory Mode".
-
AV
AV–22
Display
nrES
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Previous term
No response
Meaning
Action to be taken
The device gives no response to any one of "System Check Mode ON
Request", "System Check Result Request", and "Diagnostic Memory
Request".
Check the power source
circuit and the
communication circuit of
the component indicated
by the component code
(physical address).
(c) Device name and physical address
Physical address No.
Name
190
Radio receiver
440
Stereo component amplifier
1B0
Television display assembly
(d) Service check mode
(1) Press the "SEEK TRACK" switch to see the
check result of each component.
(2) The component code (physical address) is
displayed first, and then the check result follows.
HINT:
• If all check results are "good", the system
judges that no DTC exists.
• If the preset switch "1" is pressed in the
service check mode, service check is
performed again.
• This illustration is only an example and may
differ in cases such as for each option part
and output DTCs.
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–23
Service Check Mode:
(*1)
(*2)
(*3)
(*1)
(*2)
(*4)
(*1)
(*2)
(*3)
(*1)
PRESET SWITCH “2”
(*2)
Detailed Information Mode 1
(*4)
(*1)
(*2)
PRESET SWITCH “3”
(*3)
(*1)
PRESET SWITCH “2”
(*2)
Detailed Information Mode 2
(*4)
(*1)
(*2)
PRESET SWITCH “3”
Continues to display check result when
more components are installed.
(*1)
(*1)
(*2)
(*5)
(*2)
PRESET SWITCH “5”
(Press for 2 seconds or more)
DTC Clear
(*6)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*4: Result
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
*5: Up-to-date connection check number
*3: P...Indicates physical address
*6: Memory clear
190/440/1C6...Physical address
E110920E07
(e) Detailed information mode 1
HINT:
• "Detailed information mode 1" is displayed when
there is no response to "System Check Result
Request" and DTC is detected only in
"Diagnostic Memory Request".
• The component device code (physical address)
is displayed first, and then the check result
follows.
AV
AV–24
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• This illustration is only an example and may differ
in cases such as for each option part and output
DTCs.
(1) Press the preset switch "2" to go to the "Detailed
Information Mode 1".
(2) Press the "SEEK TRACK" switch to display the
physical address and DTC of the component.
(3) Press the preset switch "3" to go to the "Service
Check Mode".
(4) Distinguish between the displays of the
responses to "System Check Result Request"
and "Diagnostic Memory Request". In order to
distinguish the information detected in "System
Check Mode" and "Diagnostic Memory Mode" in
"ECHn", "CHEC", and "OLd" in "Detailed
Information Mode 1", refer to the following:
• "SyS" is displayed before the detailed codes
detected as a result of "System Check Result
Request" are displayed.
• "COdE" is displayed before the detailed
codes detected as a result of "Diagnostic
Memory Request" are displayed.
HINT:
• The response to "System Check Result
Request" is the current information given
from each ECU as a result of the system
check.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory
Request" contains the information received
from each ECU or stored in each ECU in the
past.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory
Request" is the output DTCs as a result of the
diagnostic memory check or the DTCs
received from each ECU.
• "System Check Result Request (SyS)" is
displayed first, and then the logical address
and DTC appear in order.
• "Diagnostic Memory Request (COdE)" is
displayed first, and then the logical address,
DTC, sub-code, connection check number,
and the number of occurrence appear in
order.
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–25
Service Check Mode:
(*1)
PRESET SWITCH “3”
Detailed Information Mode 1:
(DTC is detected only in the
response to “Diagnostic
Memory Request”.)
(*2)
PRESET SWITCH “2”
(*2)
(*1)
(*3)
(*1)
PRESET SWITCH “5”
(*2)
(*4)
(*1)
(*2)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
(*5)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*7)
(*1)
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
*3: P...Indicates physical address
(*6)
Detailed information of
the first code is
displayed.
(Press for 2 seconds or more)
(*2)
440...Physical address
*4: “COdE” indicates the display
start of the response to “Diagnostic
Memory Request”.
(*8)
(*1)
(*2)
*5: 1...The first code
(*9)
(*1)
(*2)
01...Logical address
(*10)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*11)
(*1)
(*2)
(*8)
(*1)
DC...DTC
*7: Physical address appears as the
sub-code.
*8: Connection check number
(*2)
(*9)
(*1)
*6: 1...The first code
d...Indicates DTC
(*10)
Detailed information of
the second code is
displayed.
L...Indicates logical address
*9: The number of times of
occurrence
(*2)
Continues to display detailed
information when more DTCs
are detected.
*10: 2...The second code
*11: For DTCs without sub-codes,
physical address is not displayed.
AV
(*1)
(*2)
E110919E06
AV–26
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(f)
AV
Detailed information mode 2
HINT:
• "Detailed information mode 2" is displayed when
DTCs are detected in the responses to both
"System Check Result Request" and "Diagnostic
Memory Request".
• The component device code (physical address)
is displayed first, and then the check result
follows.
• This illustration is only an example and may differ
in cases such as for each option part and output
DTCs.
(1) Press the preset switch "2" to go to the "Detailed
Information Mode 2".
(2) Press the "SEEK TRACK" switch to display the
physical address and DTC of the component.
(3) Press the preset switch "3" to go to the "Service
Check Mode".
(4) Distinguish between the displays of the
responses to "System Check Result Request"
and "Diagnostic Memory Request". In order to
distinguish the information detected in "System
Check Mode" and "Diagnostic Memory Mode" in
"ECHn", "CHEC", and "OLd" in "Detailed
Information Mode 2", refer to the following:
• "SyS" is displayed before the detailed codes
detected as a result of "System Check Result
Request" are displayed.
• "COdE" is displayed before the detailed
codes detected as a result of "Diagnostic
Memory Request" are displayed.
HINT:
• The response to "System Check Result
Request" is the current information given
from each ECU as a result of the system
check.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory
Request" contains the information received
from each ECU or stored in each ECU in the
past.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory
Request" is the output DTCs as a result of the
diagnostic memory check or the DTCs
received from each ECU.
• "System Check Result Request (SyS)" is
displayed first, and then the logical address
and DTC appear in order.
• "Diagnostic Memory Request (COdE)" is
displayed first, and then the logical address,
DTC, sub-code, connection check number,
and the number of occurrence appear in
order.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–27
System Check Mode:
PRESET SWITCH “3”
PRESET SWITCH “2”
Detailed Information Mode 2:
(DTCs are detected in the
responses to both “System Check
Result Request” and “Diagnostic
Memory Request”.)
(*1)
(*2)
(*3)
(*1)
(*2)
PRESET SWITCH “5”
(Press 2 seconds or more)
(*4)
(*1)
(*2)
L...Indicates logical address
(*5)
Detailed information of the
first code is displayed.
(*1)
(*2)
62...Logical address
*6: 1...The first code
(*6)
(*1)
*5: 1...The first code
(*2)
d...Indicates DTC
47...DTC
Continues to display (*12)
(*1)
(*2)
*7: “COdE” indicates the display
start of the response to “Diagnostic
Memory Request”.
(*7)
(*1)
(*2)
(*8)
Detailed information of the
second code is displayed.
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*9)
(*1)
(*2)
(*10)
(*1)
(*2)
(*11)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
(*1)
*8: 2...The second code
*9: Physical address appears as
the sub-code.
*10: Connection check number
*11: The number of times of
occurrence
*12: Continues to display detailed
information when more DTCs are
detected in the response to “System
Check Result Request”.
(*2)
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
*3: P...Indicates physical address
Continues to display (*13)
190...Physical address
*4: “SyS” indicates the display start
of the response to “System Check
Result Request”.
(*1)
(*2)
*13: Continues to display detailed
information when more DTCs are
detected in the response to
“Diagnostic Memory Request”.
AV
E110918E05
AV–28
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
7.
10 Speaker System:
1
5
6 Speaker System:
1
5
E121228E01
AV
DTC CLEAR/RECHECK
(a) Clearing All DTC Memory (when clearing all the
memory of the DTCs previously detected).
(1) When the preset switch "5" is pressed for 2
seconds or more during "Service Check Mode",
the DTCs for all components are cleared. ("CLr"
is displayed at this time.)
HINT:
• A beep sound is emitted once when the DTC
memory is completely cleared.
• When the DTC memory for all the
components is cleared, only the component
codes (physical address) are displayed.
• After the DTC memory is cleared, the
"Service Check Mode" is restored.
(b) Clearing Individual DTC Memory (when clearing the
memory of the DTC previously detected
individually).
(1) When the preset switch "5" is pressed for 2
seconds or more during "Detailed Information
Mode 1" or "Detailed Information Mode 2", the
DTCs for the target component are cleared.
HINT:
• A beep sound is emitted once when the DTC
memory is completely cleared.
• When the DTC memory is cleared, only the
component code (physical address) is
displayed for the target component.
• After the DTC memory is cleared, the
"Service Check Mode" is restored.
• To check DTCs, press the preset switch "1"
and perform the system check again.
(c) Press the preset switch "1" to perform the service
check again, and check that no DTCs are displayed
for all the component codes (physical address).
AV–139
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Stereo Component Amplifier Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
Example:
Service Check Mode
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
Detailed Information Mode
*3
*4
Continues to display check result when more
components are installed.
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*2
*1
*1
*2
*1
*1
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2
DTC
Component
shown by the
sub-code
Continues to display detailed information
of the first code.
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
*1
*2
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*1
*2
E110917E05
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "190 (radio receiver)" is the component shown by the subcode in the example shown in the illustration.
AV
AV–140
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Television display assembly (1B0)
Television display assembly power source circuit (See page AV-163)
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (See page AV-146)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
AV
TXM-
TXM+
E119766E04
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–141
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (See page AV-15).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the stereo component
amplifier and the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the stereo
component amplifier and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the stereo component amplifier and the
component shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AV
AV–142
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
R1 ATX+
TXM+ R4
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
S22
TX-
9
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
6 Speaker System:
TXM+ R4
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
E119767E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
AV
OK
END
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY (BUILT-IN STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
AV–143
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Television Display Assembly Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
Example:
Service Check Mode
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
Detailed Information Mode
*3
*4
Continues to display check result when more
components are installed.
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
*2
*1
*1
*2
*1
*1
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2
DTC
Component
shown by the
sub-code
Continues to display detailed information
of the first code.
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
*1
*2
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*1
*2
E110917E06
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "190 (radio receiver)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
AV
AV–144
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (See page AV-146)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (See page AV-148)
NEXE
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
AV
TXM-
TXM+
E119766E04
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–145
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY - COMPONENT
SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (See page AV-15).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the television display
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the television
display assembly and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the television display assembly and the
component shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AV
AV–146
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
R1 ATX+
TXM+ R4
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
S22
TX-
9
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
6 Speaker System:
TXM+ R4
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
E119767E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
AV
END
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
AV–169
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR ARMLEST ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
AV
B120197E03
AV–170
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
FRONT DOOR LOWER
FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
AV
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120198E02
AV–147
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Radio Receiver Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the radio receiver.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver
RADIO No. 1
From Battery
4
R2
2
R1
(*1)
(*2)
3
R2
R1
(*1)
(*2)
7
R2
20
R1
(*1)
(*2)
B (*2)
+B (*1)
ACC CUT Relay
From ACC Fuse
11
ACC
GND
*1: 6 Speaker System
*2: 10 Speaker System
E120046E01
AV
AV–148
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
Wire Harness View (10 Speaker System):
R1
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connector R1 or R2.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
+B - GND (*1)
Always
10 to 14 V
B - GND (*2)
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
B
ACC
GND
*1: 6 Speaker
*2: 10 Speaker
Wire Harness View (6 Speaker System):
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R2
+B
ACC
GND
E120030E04
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–149
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Stereo Component Amplifier Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the stereo component amplifier.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
RADIO No. 2
From Battery
1
S23 +B
10
S23 +B2
ACC CUT Relay
From ACC Fuse
12
S23 ACC
15
S23 GND2
16
S23 GND
E120047E01
AV
AV–150
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
S23
S22
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard voltage
+B
GND
GND2
+B2
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
+B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
+B2 - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
ACC
E120048E04
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–152
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
Television display assembly
Radio and navigation assembly (*1)
Radio receiver (*2)
Remote Controller (Switch assembly)
OUTLINE
• As a unique feature of Rear Seat Entertainment
(RSE) system, the front and rear seat occupants can
enjoy different audio-visual modes at the same time.
Thus, this system offers enhanced entertainment to
the rear seat occupants.
• The rear seat occupants can control the audio-visual
modes with the remote controller (switch assembly),
and listen to the audio using wireless headphones.
• The RSE system is controlled by the television display
assembly, and the communication between the audio
head unit and the television display assembly is
established via an AVC-LAN (Audio Visual
Communication-Local Area Network).
• The RSE system can play discs recorded entirely in
the MP3 format, as well as music discs containing a
mixture of CD data (CD-DA files) and MP3 data.
HINT:
MP3 is short for MPEG1 (Moving Picture Expert Group
Phase 1) & 2 Audio Layer 3.
It is an audio compression standard set by a working
group (MPEG) of the ISO (International Standards
Organization). MP3 is able to compress audio data to
about 1/10 the level of a conventional disc.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
•
•
•
Displays DVD and Video images.
Receives signals from the remote controller.
Outputs audio signals to the wireless headphones in the form of infrared signals.
•
Receives audio signals from the television display assembly and outputs them to the stereo
component amplifier.
Enables or disables the function of the remote controller for the television display assembly.
•
Outputs various control signals of the RSE system to the television display assembly in the form of
infrared signals.
Wireless headphones
•
•
Receives the audio signals from the television display assembly in the form of infrared signals.
Volume adjustment of the wireless headphones can be done by using the volume control on the
wireless headphones.
VTR terminal
This terminal is for connecting a video player's video and audio output terminals.
*1: with Navigation System
*2: without Navigation System
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
AV–153
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Interview the customer and confirm the trouble.
(1) Confirm the problem by duplicating the conditions
described by the customer.
NEXT
3
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Basic inspection.
(1) Measure the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
(b) with Navigation system:
Check the power supply to the radio and navigation
assembly.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(2) Check whether the display appears on the radio and
navigation assembly.
(c) without Navigation system:
Check the power supply to the radio receiver.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(2) Check whether the display appears on the radio
receiver.
DISPLAY DOES NOT APPEAR (GO TO
"NAVIGATION SYSTEM" OR "AUDIO AND
VISUAL SYSTEM").
DISPLAY APPEARS (Go to step 4).
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Refer to the problem symptoms table (See page AV154).
NEXT
AV
AV–154
5
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
CIRCUIT INSPECTION AND PART INSPECTION
NEXT
6
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
AV
CONFIRMATION TEST
AV–155
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Inspect the "Fuse" and "Relay" before confirming the
suspected area as shown in the table below.
DISPLAY FUNCTION:
Symptom
Black screen (When a disc is inserted, or when the
system is in the VTR mode.)
Only the DVD screen is not displayed or not stable.
Only display screen input from an external device is
not displayed or not stable.
Suspected area
See page
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
2. AVC-LAN circuit (*1)
AV-128
3. AVC-LAN circuit (*2)
NS-201
4. Television display assembly
AV-177
5. Radio receiver (*1)
AV-167
6. Radio and navigation assembly (*2)
NS-235
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
2. Television display assembly
AV-177
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
2. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit Between Video Terminal
and Television Display Assembly"
AV-160
3. Video terminal
AV-188
4. Television display assembly
AV-177
SOUND FUNCTION:
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
Quality of sound from wireless headphones is poor or
no sound can be heard.
Only DVD sound cannot be heard or the sound quality
is poor.
Only sound quality input from an external device is
poor or no sound can be heard.
See page
AV-163
2. Wireless headphone
-
3. Television display assembly
AV-177
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
2. Television display assembly
AV-177
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
2. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Video Terminal
and Television Display Assembly"
AV-157
3. Video terminal
AV-188
4. Television display assembly
AV-177
REMOTE CONTROL FUNCTION:
Symptom
Remote control system does not operate.
Suspected area
See page
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
AV-163
2. Proceed to "A Remote Control System does not Operate"
AV-156
3. AVC-LAN circuit (*1)
AV-128
4. AVC-LAN circuit (*2)
NS-201
5. Remote controller
-
6. Television display assembly
AV-177
*1: without Navigation System
*2: with Navigation System
AV
AV–156
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
R18
E119739E02
AV
Terminal
Description
Condition
Specification
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
NTS4 (R18-6) - GND6 (R18-12)
G - BR
Display Signal
External device system is playing
(When VTR jack is used)
Pulse generation
AUXR (R18-7) - GND6 (R18-12)
V - BR
Sound Signal
External device system is playing
(When VTR jack is used)
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
AUXL (R18-8) - GND6 (R18-12)
LG - BR
Sound Signal
External device system is playing
(When VTR jack is used)
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
SGN1 (R18-9) - GND6 (R18-12)
Shielded - BR
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
SG3 (R18-10) - GND6 (R18-12)
L - BR
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
NTS1 (R18-11) - GND6 (R18-12)
P - BR
Display Signal
DVD image is displayed
GND6 (R18-12) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
TX- (R18-13) - GND6 (R18-12)
G - BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Ignition switch ACC
2 to 3 V
TX+ (R18-14) - GND6 (R18-12)
L - BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Ignition switch ACC
2 to 3 V
Pulse generation
Below 1 V
ACC4 (R18-15) - GND6 (R18-12)
GR - BR
Ignition (ACC)
Ignition switch ACC
10 to 14 V
+B2 (R18-16) - GND6 (R18-12)
L-Y - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
SGN5 (R18-22) - GND6 (R18-12)
R - BR
SG7 (R18-23) - GND6 (R18-12)
Shielded - BR
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
OPEN (R18-24) - GND6 (R18-12)
G - BR
VTR terminal
detection
Always
Below 1 V
LMUT (R18-26) - GND6 (R18-12)
V - BR
Mute signal
RSE system is playing
LMUT (R18-26) - GND6 (R18-12)
V - BR
Mute signal
RSE system is changing
SG1 (R18-27) - GND6 (R18-12)
Shielded - BR
Shielded ground
Always
Above 3.5 V
Below 1 V
Below 1 V
R+ (R18-28) - GND6 (R18-12)
B - BR
RSE sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
R- (R18-29) - GND6 (R18-12)
W - BR
RSE sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
L+ (R18-30) - GND6 (R18-12)
R - BR
RSE sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
L- (R18-31) - GND6 (R18-12)
G - BR
RSE sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
AV–157
A Remote Control System does not Operate
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SYSTEM
(a) Check that the remote control operation of the rear
system is not locked by the radio receiver or the radio
and navigation assembly.
(1) Check if "Rear System Locked" appears on the
television display assembly.
OK:
The message does not appear.
NG
E119740
ENABLE THE REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT
SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK BATTERY (REMOTE CONTROLLER)
(a) Check the battery.
(1) Check that the dry-cell battery used for the remote
controller is not depleted.
OK:
It is not depleted.
NG
REPLACE BATTERY (REMOTE
CONTROLLER)
OK
3
CLEAN TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (INFRARED RAY EMITTING PORTION)
(a) Clean the infrared ray emitting portion.
(1) Clean the infrared ray emitting portion on the rear
display assembly.
(2) Check whether the same malfunction occurs.
OK:
The function returns to normal.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
E124109
OK
END
AV
AV–158
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Video Terminal and Television Display
DESCRIPTION
This is the sound signal circuit from the video (video adapter) terminal to the television display assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
V14
Viedo Terminal
Television Display Assembly
(Shielded)
SGND
3
AUXR 1
AUXL
CE
2
8
23
R18 SG7
7
R18 AUXR
8
R18 AUXL
24
R18 OPEN
E124110E01
AV
AV–159
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY - VIDEO
TERMINAL)
Video Terminal Wire Harness View:
V14
SGND
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the video (video
adapter) terminal and television display assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SGND - SG7
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXR - AUXR
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXL - AUXL
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXL
AUXR
CE
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
CE - OPEN
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXR - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AUXL - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R18
AUXR
AUXL
SG7
OPEN
E119743E03
OK
2
INSPECT VIDEO TERMINAL
Video Terminal Wire Harness View:
AUXL
V14
AUXR
E110048E05
(a) Reconnect the video (video adapter) terminal connector.
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform
between each terminal and body ground according to the
conditions, as shown in the chart.
HINT:
An external device system is playing (When the video
(video adapter) terminal is used).
Signal waveform
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
AUXL - Body ground
Sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized with sound
is output
AUXR - Body ground
Sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized with sound
is output
AV
AV–160
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE VIDEO TERMINAL
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–161
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Display Signal Circuit between Video Terminal and Television Display
DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit from the video terminal to the television display assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
V14
Video Terminal
Television Display Assembly
(Shielded)
SLD 7
NTSC 5
6
R18 NTS4
SGND 6
22
R18 SGN5
8
24
R18 OPEN
CE
E124111E01
AV
AV–162
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY - VIDEO
TERMINAL)
Video Terminal Wire Harness View:
V14
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the video terminal and
television display assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
CE - OPEN
Always
Below 1 Ω
NTSC
CE
SGND
SLD
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
NTSC - NTS4
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGND - SGN5
Always
Below 1 Ω
NTSC - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SGND - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R18
NTS4
SGN5
OPEN
E119743E04
OK
2
INSPECT VIDEO TERMINAL
Video Terminal Wire Harness View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
NTSC - SGND
External device is
playing
A waveform
synchronized with
display signals is output
HINT:
The waveform pattern may differ from that shown in the
illustration below due to differences in oscilloscope
setting. A normal video terminal operating condition can
be determined if any waveform is output.
SGND
V14
AV
(a) Reconnect the video (video adapter) terminal connector.
(b) Measure the waveform according to the table below.
OK
NTSC
E110048E06
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
AV–163
(c) Oscilloscope waveform
(1) Terminal: NTSC - Body ground
Setting: 200mV/DIV, 10 µs/DIV
Condition: DVD display is ON.
GND
NG
REPLACE VIDEO TERMINAL
E119745E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–164
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Television Display Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source circuit to operate the television display assembly.
AV
AV–165
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display Assembly
Short Pin
RADIO No. 1
I18
Ignition SW
ACC
AM1
ALT
ACC CUT Relay
16
R18 +B2
15
R18 ACC4
12
R18 GND6
Battery
E119746E01
AV
AV–166
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector from the television display
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R18
+B2
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
GND6 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
+B2 - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC4 - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
ACC4
GND6
E113507E04
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–168
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL RADIO NO. 2 BRACKET
2.
INSTALL RADIO NO. 1 BRACKET
3.
INSTALL RADIO RECEIVER (w/ Bracket)
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
5.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
7.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
8.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
10. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
AV
AV–29
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
COMMUNICATION DIAGNOSIS:
DTC No.
01-21
Detection Item
Trouble Area
ROM Error
Radio receiver
See page
AV-32
01-22
RAM Error
Radio receiver
AV-32
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
1. Power source circuit of the
component shown by the subcode
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the subcode
AV-33
01-D6
No Master
1. Radio receiver power source
circuit
2. Power source circuit of the
component which has stored this
code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code
4. Component which has stored
this code
5. Radio receiver
AV-35
01-D7
Connection Check Error
1. Radio receiver power source
circuit
2. Power source circuit of the
component which has stored this
code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code
4. Component which has stored
this code
5. Radio receiver
AV-35
01-D8
No Response for Connection
Check
1. Power source circuit of the
component shown by the subcode
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the subcode
AV-33
01-D9
Last Mode Error
1. Power source circuit of the
component shown by the subcode
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the subcode
AV-33
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF
Command
1. Power source circuit of the
component shown by the subcode
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the subcode
AV-33
AV
AV–30
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Area
See page
01-DB
Mode Status Error
Detection Item
1. Power source circuit of the
component shown by the subcode
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the subcode
AV-33
01-DC
Transmission Error
If the same sub-code is recorded
in other components, check
harness for power supply and
communication system of all
components shown by code
AV-40
01-DD
Master Reset
1. Radio receiver power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code
3. Radio receiver
4. Component which has stored
this code
AV-43
01-DE
Slave Reset
1. Power source circuit of the
component shown by the subcode
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the subcode
AV-33
01-DF
Master Error
1. Radio receiver power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code
3. Radio receiver
4. Component which has stored
this code
AV-48
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication
Error
-
AV-53
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON
Error
1. Radio receiver power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the
radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code
3. Radio receiver
4. Component which has stored
this code
AV-43
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter
Error
Radio receiver
AV-54
01-E3
Registration Demand
Transmission
-
AV-53
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
-
AV-53
DVD PLAYER:
DTC No.
AV
Detection Item
44-10
DVD Player Mechanical Error
Trouble Area
See page
Television display assembly
AV-55
44-11
DVD Insertion and Eject Error
Television display assembly
AV-55
44-12
DVD Reading Abnormal
Television display assembly
AV-55
44-41
Wrong Disc
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-56
44-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-56
AV–31
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
44-43
DVD-ROM Abnormal
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-58
44-44
DVD Error
Television display assembly
AV-59
44-45
Eject Error
Television display assembly
AV-60
44-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-61
44-47
High Temperature
Television display assembly
AV-63
44-48
Excess Current
Television display assembly
AV-59
44-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Television display assembly
AV-59
44-51
Elevator Error
Television display assembly
AV-60
44-52
Clamp Error
Television display assembly
AV-60
44-78
DSP Error
-
AV-64
44-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-65
44-7E
No Playable Files
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-65
44-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
AV-65
CD PLAYER
DTC No.
62-10
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
CD Player Mechanical Error
Radio receiver
AV-66
62-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-66
62-12
CD Reading Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-66
62-41
Wrong Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-67
62-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-67
62-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-69
62-44
CD Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-71
62-45
Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-72
62-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-73
62-47
High Temperature
Radio receiver
AV-75
62-48
Excess Current
Radio receiver
AV-71
62-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Radio receiver
AV-71
62-51
Elevator Error
Radio receiver
AV-72
62-52
Clamp Error
Radio receiver
AV-72
62-78
DSP Error
-
AV-76
62-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
62-7E
No Playable Files
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
62-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
IN-DASH CD CHANGER
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
63-10
CD Changer Mechanical Error
Radio receiver
AV-66
63-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-66
63-12
CD Reading Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-66
63-41
Wrong Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-67
AV
AV–32
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC No.
AV
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
63-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-67
63-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-69
63-44
CD Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-71
63-45
Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-72
63-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-73
63-47
High Temperature
Radio receiver
AV-75
63-48
Excess Current
Radio receiver
AV-71
63-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Radio receiver
AV-71
63-51
Elevator Error
Radio receiver
AV-72
63-52
Clamp Error
Radio receiver
AV-72
63-78
DSP Error
-
AV-76
63-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
63-7E
No Playable Files
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
63-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
AV–171
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
HINT:
Remove interior parts so that the front No. 1 speaker can
be seen.
(a) Check the speaker installation.
OK:
The speaker is securely installed.
If the result is not as specified, reinstall the front No.
1 speaker.
(b) Visually check the speaker.
OK:
The cone paper of the speaker is not torn.
If the result is not as specified, replace the front No.
1 speaker.
(c) Speaker resistance check
(1) Disconnect the front No. 1 speaker connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the terminals
of the speaker.
Standard resistance:
6 Speaker System: Approximately 4 Ω
10 Speaker System: 4 to 6 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the front
No. 1 speaker.
2.
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
HINT:
Remove interior parts so that the front No. 2 speaker can
be seen.
(a) Check the speaker installation.
OK:
The speaker is securely installed.
If the result is not as specified, reinstall the front No.
2 speaker.
(b) Visually check the speaker.
OK:
The cone paper of the speaker is not torn.
If the result is not as specified, replace the front No.
2 speaker.
AV
AV–172
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-28)
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-28)
3.
REMOVE FRONT ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH (See
page ED-28)
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-28)
5.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 4 screws and front No. 1 speaker.
6.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the connector and remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Remove the front No. 2 speaker from speaker
mounting bracket No. 1.
I031482
I033307
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
AV–173
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Align a claw with the notch of the speaker mounting
bracket No. 1, and install the front No. 2 speaker
with 2 bolts.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Install the front No. 1 speaker with the 4 crews.
NOTICE:
Install them in the order shown in the
illustration.
(b) Connect the connector.
3.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
4.
INSTALL FRONT ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
5.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
AV–173
FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
B120192E04
AV–174
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
FRONT STEREO COMPONENT
SPEAKER
AV
E115640E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
AV–175
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
HINT:
Remove interior parts so that the front stereo component
speaker can be seen.
(a) Check the speaker installation.
OK:
The speaker is securely installed.
If the result is not as specified, reinstall the front
stereo component speaker.
(b) Visually check the speaker.
OK:
The cone paper of the speaker is not torn.
If the result is not as specified, replace the front
stereo component speaker.
(c) Speaker resistance check
(1) Disconnect the front stereo component speaker
connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the terminals
of the speaker.
Standard resistance:
1.2 to 2.2 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the front
stereo component speaker.
AV
AV–176
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
REMOVAL
I033308
AV
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the instrument
panel sub-assembly (See page IP-6).
2.
REMOVE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screw and front stereo component
speaker.
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
AV–177
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures of the instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly (See page IP-12).
AV
AV–178
AUDIO / VISUAL – TELEVISION DISPLAY
INSTALLATION
AV
1.
INSTALL TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL DOME LIGHT LENS RH
4.
INSTALL DOME LIGHT LENS LH
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
AV–181
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the instrument
panel sub-assembly (See page IP-6).
2.
REMOVE ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 clamps and antenna cord subassembly.
4 Clamps
I033314E01
AV
AV–182
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
INSTALLATION
AV
1.
INSTALL ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures of the instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly (See page IP-12).
AV–184
AUDIO / VISUAL – AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
REMOVAL
4 Clamps
1.
REMOVE SUN ROOF OR REMOVABLE ROOF
HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the sun roof or
removable roof headlining assembly (See page IR-7).
2.
REMOVE AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
(a) Disconnect the connectors and remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Remove the 17 clamps and amplifier antenna.
Clamp
11 Clamps
Clamp
I034049E02
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
AV–185
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
2.
INSTALL SUN ROOF OR REMOVABLE ROOF
HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures of the roof headlining
assembly (See page IR-14).
AV
AV–188
AUDIO / VISUAL – VIDEO TERMINAL
REMOVAL
E115645
AV
1.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
2.
REMOVE VIDEO TERMINAL
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Disengage the wire harness clamp.
(c) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the video (video
adapter) terminal.
AUDIO / VISUAL – VIDEO TERMINAL
AV–189
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL VIDEO TERMINAL
2.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
AV
AV–33
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-21
ROM Error
DTC
01-22
RAM Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-21
A malfunction exists in ROM.
01-22
A malfunction exists in RAM.
Trouble Area
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
NEXT
END
AV
AV–34
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
DTC
01-D8
No Response for Connection Check
DTC
01-D9
Last Mode Error
DTC
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF Command
DTC
01-DB
Mode Status Error
DTC
01-DE
Slave Reset
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-D5
*1, *3
A device that the sub-code shows is (was)
disconnected from the system when turning the ignition
switch to the ON or ACC position.
The communication condition with the device that the
code shows cannot be obtained when the engine starts.
01-D8
*2, *3
The device indicated by the sub-code is (was)
disconnected from the system after the engine starts.
01-D9
*1, *3
The device that had functioned before the engine
stopped is (was) disconnected from the system when
the engine switch is (was) in the ON or ACC position.
01-DA
*3
No response is identified when changing mode.
Sound and image do not change by switch operation.
01-DB
*1, *3
A dual alarm is detected.
01-DE
*3, *4
A slave device has been disconnected after the engine
starts
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Power source circuit of the component shown by
the sub-code
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component shown by the sub-code
Component shown by the sub-code
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
engine start voltage.
• *2: If the power connector is disconnected after the engine starts, this code is stored after 180 seconds.
• *3: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
• *4: This code may be stored if the engine is started and the ignition switch is turned to the START
position again.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio receiver is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
AV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
1
AV–35
CHECK "RADIO RECEIVER COMMUNICATION ERROR" IN FLOW CHART
Refer to the radio receiver communication error (See page
AV-134).
NEXT
END
AV
AV–176
AUDIO / VISUAL – TELEVISION DISPLAY
TELEVISION DISPLAY
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
TELEVISION DISPLAY
ASSEMBLY
DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY
AV
E115641E06
AUDIO / VISUAL – TELEVISION DISPLAY
AV–177
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE DOME LIGHT LENS LH
(a) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the dome the
light lens LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE DOME LIGHT LENS RH
(a) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the dome light
lens RH.
HINT:
Tape the screw driver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
E115648
E115649
E115650
(b) Disengage the 4 clips.
(c) Disconnect the connector and remove the dome
light assembly.
E116107
4.
REMOVE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts.
(c) Disengage the 2 clips and remove television display
assembly.
AV
E116108
AV–36
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-D6
No Master
DTC
01-D7
Connection Check Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-D6
*1
When either of the following conditions is met:
• The device that stores (stored) the code has (had)
been disconnected when the ignition switch is in
the ACC or ON position
• The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is stored
01-D7
*2
When either of the following conditions is met:
• The device that stored the code has (had) been
disconnected after the engine starts (started)
• The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Radio receiver power source circuit
Power source circuit of the component which has
stored this code
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component which has stored this code
Component which has stored this code
Radio receiver
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
engine start voltage.
• *2: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio receiver is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
Refer to the radio receiver power source circuit (See page
AV-146).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
2
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
AV
AV–37
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Example:
(*1)
Service Check Mode
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
Detailed Information Mode
Component which has stored this code
(*3)
(*4)
Continues to display check result when
more components are installed.
(*1)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*2)
(*2)
(*1)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
DTC
Continues to display detailed information of
the first code.
(*1)
(*2)
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
(*1)
(*2)
E110915E04
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Component
Physical address
Stereo component amplifier
440
Television display assembly
1B0
HINT:
• "440 (stereo component amplifier)" is the component
which has stored this code in the example shown in the
illustration.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
AV
AV–38
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NEXT
3
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component which
has stored this code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Stereo component amplifier
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (See page AV-148)
Television display assembly
Television display assembly power source circuit (See page AV-163)
NEXT
4
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
TXM-
TXM+
AV
E119766E04
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–39
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page AV-15).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio
receiver and the component which has stored this
code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
R1 ATX+
TXM+ R4
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
TX- S22
9
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
6 Speaker System:
TXM+ R4
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
E119767E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
AV
AV–40
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
6
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Replace the component which has stored this code with
a normal one and check if the same problem occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
AV–179
RADIO ANTENNA CORD
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
B120192E05
AV–180
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
E115641E07
AV–41
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-DC
Transmission Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
01-DC
*1
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Transmission to component shown by sub-code failed
(Detecting this DTC does not always mean actual
failure)
If the same sub-code is recorded in other components,
check harness for power supply and communication
system of all components shown by code
HINT:
*1: This code may be stored if the engine is started, idled for 60 seconds and then started again.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio receiver is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK FOR DTC OF OTHER COMPONENTS
(a) Check if the component shown by the sub-code is
displayed in the check result of the other components.
(1) Check if "01-DC" is output for the other
components.
(2) If "01-DC" is output for any other components,
check if the same physical address is displayed.
Result
Result
Proceed to
"01-DC" is output and the same
physical address is displayed
A
"01-DC" is not output or the same
physical address is not displayed
B
HINT:
For the list of the components shown by sub-codes, refer to
the table in step 2.
B
Go to step 4
A
2
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
AV
AV–42
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Example:
(*1)
Service Check Mode
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
Detailed Information Mode
Component which has stored this code
(*3)
(*4)
Continues to display check result when
more components are installed.
(*1)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*2)
(*2)
(*1)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
DTC
Continues to display detailed information of
the first code.
(*1)
(*2)
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
(*1)
(*2)
E110915E04
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Component
AV
Physical address
Stereo component amplifier
440
Television display assembly
1B0
Radio receiver
190
HINT:
• "440 (stereo component amplifier)" is the component
which has stored this code in the example shown in the
illustration.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–43
NEXT
3
CHECK COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Select the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Stereo component amplifier
Stereo component amplifier communication error (See page AV-138)
Television display assembly
Television display assembly communication error (See page AV-142)
Radio receiver
Radio receiver communication error (See page AV-134)
NEXT
END
4
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page AV-19).
HINT:
If "01-DC" is output for only one component, this may not
indicate a malfunction.
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble code
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
END
AV
AV–182
AUDIO / VISUAL – AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
SUN ROOF OR REMOVABLE ROOF
HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
AV
B120189E02
AUDIO / VISUAL – AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
AV–183
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
AV
E115641E08
AV–44
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-DD
Master Reset
DTC
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-DD
*1
The device that should be the master has been
disconnected after engine start
•
•
01-E1
*2
The AMP device records that the AMP output does not
function even while the source device operates
•
•
Radio receiver power source circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component which has stored this code
Radio receiver
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*1: This code may be stored if the engine is started and the ignition switch is turned to START position
again.
*2: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
engine start voltage.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio receiver is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
Refer to the radio receiver power source circuit (See page
AV-146).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
AV
AV–45
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
10 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R1
R4
ATX+ ATX-
TXM- TXM+
(a) Disconnect the radio receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R1-5) - ATX- (R115) (*1)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R4-9) - TXM- (R410)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
*1: 10 Speaker System
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
6 Speaker System Wire Harness View:
R4
TXM-
TXM+
E119766E04
OK
3
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
AV
AV–46
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Example:
(*1)
Service Check Mode
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
Detailed Information Mode
Component which has stored this code
(*3)
(*4)
Continues to display check result when
more components are installed.
(*1)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*1)
(*2)
(*2)
(*2)
(*1)
*1: SEEK TRACK DOWN
*2: SEEK TRACK UP
DTC
Continues to display detailed information of
the first code.
(*1)
(*2)
Continues to display detailed information when
more DTCs are detected.
*3: PRESET SWITCH “2”
*4: PRESET SWITCH “3”
(*1)
(*2)
E110915E04
(b) Press the preset switch "3" to change to "Detailed
Information Mode".
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table
Component
AV
Physical address
Stereo component amplifier
440
Television display assembly
1B0
HINT:
• "440 (stereo component amplifier)" is the component
which has stored this code in the example shown in the
illustration.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DTC CHECK/
CLEAR" (See page AV-19).
AV–47
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NEXT
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO RECEIVER - COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page AV-15).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio
receiver and the component which has stored this
code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio receiver and the component
which has stored this code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
10 Speaker System:
(*2)
8
TX+ S22
5
R1 ATX+
(*3)
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
Stereo Component
Amplifier
7
TX- S22
9
TXM+ R4
(*1)
15
R1 ATX-
Television Display
Assembly
10
TXM-
R4
9
TXM+ R4
6 Speaker System:
(*3)
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
14
T18 TX+
Radio Receiver
(*2) (*3)
Television Display
Assembly
(*1)
10
TXM-
(*2) (*3)
R4
(*3)
13
T18 TX-
AV
E119767E03
AV–48
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Replace the radio receiver with a normal one and check
if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
AV–186
AUDIO / VISUAL – VIDEO TERMINAL
VIDEO TERMINAL
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
AV
B120191E04
AUDIO / VISUAL – VIDEO TERMINAL
AV–187
VIDEO TERMINAL
AV
E115639E03
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO TERMINAL
AV–191
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
2.
REMOVE STEREO JACK ADAPTER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Disengage the wire harness clamp.
(c) Disengage the 2 claws remove the stereo jack
adapter assembly.
E115647
AV
AV–192
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO TERMINAL
INSTALLATION
AV
1.
INSTALL STEREO JACK ADAPTER
2.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
AV–194
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
SEPARATE BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (See
page RS-387)
2.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
(See page RS-388)
3.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
(See page RS-387)
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS388)
5.
REMOVE STEERING PAD SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Disconnect the connector of cruise control main
switch.
(c) Remove the screw.
E062430
(d) Disengage the meshing of 2 pins remove the
steering pad switch LH.
2 Pins
2 Pins
AV
I033301E02
AV–195
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
(a) Measure the resistance according to the values in
the table below.
AU1
EAU
AU2
I039169E02
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AU1 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU1 - EAU
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the steering
pad switch LH.
AV
AV–196
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
2.
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH RH (w/ Navigation
System)
(a) Inspect steering pad switch assembly.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the values
in the table below.
Connector Front View:
A
EAU
AU2
AU1
E120112E01
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AU1 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU1 - EAU
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU2 - EAU
VOICE switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
ON HOOK switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
OFF HOOK switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
(b) Inspect steering pad switch cable.
B
21
3
4
5
6
78
C
12
3
4
5
6
87
AV
E120113E02
AV–197
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
(1) Measure the resistance according to the values
in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B-1 - C-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-2 - C-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-3 - C-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-4 - C-4
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-5 - C-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-6 - C-6
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-7 - C-7
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-8 - C-8
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-2 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-3 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-4 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-5 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-6 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-7 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-8 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the
steering pad switch cable.
(c) Inspect steering pad switch RH.
Connector Front View:
Opposite Side:
AU2 (B-5)
AU2 (B-4)
B
EAU (B-3)
EAU (B-2)
E120114E01
AV
AV–198
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
(1) Measure the resistance according to the values
in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
No switch is pushed
10 kΩ or higher
VOICE switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
ON HOOK switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
OFF HOOK switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
steering pad switch RH.
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO TERMINAL
AV–189
AUDIO TERMINAL
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
AV
B120191E05
AV–190
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO TERMINAL
STEREO JACK ADAPTER
AV
E115639E04
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
AV–199
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STEERING PAD SWITCH
2.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS388)
3.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
(See page RS-388)
4.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
(See page RS-388)
5.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
6.
INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS389)
7.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page RS-389)
AV
AV–192
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
STEERING PAD SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 3
STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO. 2
AV
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
C
C131315E04
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
AV–193
STEERING PAD SWITCH
AV
E115639E05
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
AV–201
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY (See
page IR-12)
2.
REMOVE MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
(a) Remove the 4 screws.
E116109
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Disengage the 2 claws remove the amplifier
microphone assembly.
E116240
AV
AV–202
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
INSTALLATION
AV
1.
INSTALL MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
2.
INSTALL ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY (See
page IR-15)
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
AV–199
MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
AV
B120189E03
AV–200
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
AV
E115641E09
AV–206
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-41)
2.
REMOVE REAR ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH (See page
ED-41)
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-41)
4.
REMOVE REAR SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and rear speaker.
I033309
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR SPEAKER
(a) Install the rear speaker with the 3 screws.
NOTICE:
Install them in the order shown in the
illustration.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
3.
INSTALL REAR ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
4.
INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
I033309
AV
AV–202
AUDIO / VISUAL – WINDOW GLASS ANTENNA WIRE
WINDOW GLASS ANTENNA WIRE
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
WINDOW GLASS ANTENNA WIRE
AV
E115641E10
AUDIO / VISUAL – WINDOW GLASS ANTENNA WIRE
AV–203
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT WINDOW GLASS ANTENNA WIRE
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use a soft dry cloth and
wipe the glass in the direction of the wire. Take care
not to damage the wires. Do not use detergents or
glass cleaners with abrasive ingredients. When
measuring voltage, wind a piece of tin foil around the
top of the foil negative probe and press the foil
against the wire with your finger, as shown in the
illustration.
(a) Inspect the continuity, at the center of each antenna
wire, as shown in the illustration.
E032576
REPAIR
Repair Point
1.
Broken
Wire
REPAIR WINDOW GLASS ANTENNA WIRE
(a) Clean the broken wire tips with a grease, wax and
silicone remover.
(b) Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire
to be repaired.
(c) Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont+. paste
No. 4817).
Masking Tape
BE00150E08
Fine Tip Brush
(d) Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount to the
wire.
(e) After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
(f) Do not repair the defogger were for at least 24
hours.
Repair Point
Glass
BE00151E06
AV
AV–210
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
AV
INSPECT REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
HINT:
Remove interior parts so that the rear No. 2 speaker can
be seen.
(a) Check the speaker installation.
OK:
The speaker is securely installed.
If the result is not as specified, reinstall the rear No.
2 speaker.
(b) Visually check the speaker.
OK:
The cone paper of the speaker is not torn.
If the result is not as specified, replace the rear No.
2 speaker.
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV–211
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
3.
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-7)
4.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page IR-7)
5.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR (See page IR-7)
6.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page IR-8)
7.
REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR (See page IR-8)
8.
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH (See
page IR-8)
9.
REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY LH (See page
IR-8)
10. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-8)
11. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
12. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-9)
13. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH (See page IR-10)
14. REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and rear No. 2 speaker.
I033310
AV
AV–204
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
REAR SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE BEZEL LH
REAR SPEAKER
REAR ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
AV
REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
B120199E02
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
AV–205
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT REAR SPEAKER
HINT:
Remove interior parts so that the rear speaker can be
seen.
(a) Check the speaker installation.
OK:
The speaker is securely installed.
If the result is not as specified, reinstall the rear
speaker.
(b) Visually check the speaker.
OK:
The cone paper of the speaker is not torn.
If the result is not as specified, replace the rear
speaker.
(c) Speaker resistance check
(1) Disconnect the rear speaker connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the terminals
of the speaker.
Standard resistance:
6 Speaker System: Approximately 4 Ω
10 Speaker System: Approximately 2.4 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the rear
speaker.
AV
AV–212
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH (See page IR-16)
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-16)
4.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-17)
6.
INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY LH (See page
IR-18)
7.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH (See
page IR-18)
8.
INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
9.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page IR-18)
10. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
(See page IR-18)
11. INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page IR-18)
12. INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-18)
13. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
14. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV–207
REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
B120186E04
AV–208
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
REAR FLOOR MAT
SUPPORT PLATE REAR
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
DECK TRIM
COVER REAR
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER LH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH
B120187E04
AV
AV–209
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV
E115641E04
AUDIO / VISUAL – NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
AV–215
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
HINT:
Remove interior parts so that the No. 1 speaker with box
can be seen.
(a) Check the speaker installation.
OK:
The speaker is securely installed.
If the result is not as specified, reinstall the No. 1
speaker with box.
(b) Visually check the speaker.
OK:
The cone paper of the speaker is not torn.
If the result is not as specified, replace the No. 1
speaker with box.
(c) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance according tot the
value(s) in the table below.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for
checking.
Standard resistance
I034673
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1-3
Always
Approximately 1.2 Ω
2-4
Always
Approximately 1.2 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
1 speaker with box.
AV
AV–216
AUDIO / VISUAL – NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
3.
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-7)
4.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page IR-7)
5.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR (See page IR-7)
6.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX RH (See page IR-8)
7.
REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR (See page IR-8)
8.
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH (See
page IR-8)
9.
REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH (See page
IR-8)
10. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-8)
11. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
12. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-9)
13. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (See page IR-10)
14. REMOVE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 5 bolts and woofer box speaker
assembly.
I033311
AV
AV–212
AUDIO / VISUAL – NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER RH
DECK FLOOR BOX RH
SIDE DECK TRIM PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
B120186E05
AUDIO / VISUAL – NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
AV–213
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
DECK TRIM COVER REAR RH
REAR FLOOR MAT
SUPPORT PLATE REAR
DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
B120187E06
AV
AV–214
AUDIO / VISUAL – NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
WOOFER BOX SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
AV
E115641E05
AUDIO / VISUAL – NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
AV–217
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL WOOFER BOX SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (See page IR-16)
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-16)
4.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-17)
6.
INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH (See page
IR-18)
7.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH (See
page IR-18)
8.
INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR (See page IR-18)
9.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX RH (See page IR-18)
10. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
(See page IR-18)
11. INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY (See page IR-18)
12. INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-18)
13. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
14. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
AV
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–3
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
Radio and navigation assembly outline
(a) Conventionally, 2 separate devices, a "radio and
display" and a "navigation ECU" are used. This
model has adopted a new type, combining these
devices into a single unit.
Radio and Disdplay
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Navigation ECU
E120051E01
NS
NS–4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2.
Navigation system outline
(a) Vehicle position tracking methods
It is essential that the navigation system correctly
tracks the current vehicle position and displays it on
the map. There are 2 methods to track the current
vehicle position: autonomous (dead reckoning) and
GPS* (satellite) navigation. Both navigation
methods are used in conjunction with each other.
*GPS (Global Positioning System)
GPS satellite
Location by autonomous
navigation
Navigation
Gyro Sensor
GPS Antenna
Location by
GPS navigation
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Radio and Navigation Assembly
GPS Antenna
Receive satellite radio wave
ECU
Detect the measurement position
GPS correction
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Detect vehicle running
distance
Create the current vehicle
position tracking data
Navigation screen
Detect direction change
Gyro Sensor
Map matching correction
Map disc
Map and current vehicle position
data processing
Map scrolling
Map scale switching
NS
E120052E01
NS–5
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Operation
Description
Vehicle Position Calculation
The radio and navigation assembly calculates the current vehicle
position (direction and current position) using the direction deviation
signal from the gyro sensor and the running distance signal from the
vehicle speed sensor and creates the driving route.
Map Display Processing
The radio and navigation assembly displays the vehicle track on the
map by processing the vehicle position data, vehicle running track,
and map data from the map disc.
Map Matching
The map data from the map disc is compared to the vehicle position
and running track data. Then, the vehicle position is matched with the
nearest road.
GPS Correction
The vehicle position is matched to the position measured by GPS.
Then, the measurement position data from the GPS unit is compared
with the vehicle position and running track data. If the position is
widely different, the GPS measurement position is used.
Distance Correction
The running distance signal from the vehicle speed sensor includes
the error caused by tire wear and slippage between the tires and road
surface. Distance correction is performed to account for this. The
radio and navigation assembly automatically offsets the running
distance signal to make up for the difference between it and the
distance data of the map. The offset is automatically updated.
Navigation is performed even where the GPS
radio wave does not reach.
GPS Satellite
In a tunnel
In an indoor parking lot
Between tall buildings
Under an overpass
On a forest or tree-lined path
Autonomous Navigation
Autonomous Navigation and
GPS Wave Navigation
I100028E07
NS
NS–6
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HINT:
The combination of autonomous and GPS
navigation makes it possible to display the vehicle
position even when the vehicle is in places where
the GPS radio wave cannot receive a signal. When
only autonomous navigation is used, however, the
mapping accuracy may slightly decline.
(b) Autonomous navigation
This method determines the relative vehicle position
based on the running track determined by the gyro
and vehicle speed sensors located in the radio and
navigation assembly.
(1) Gyro sensor
Calculates the direction by detecting angular
velocity. It is located in the radio and navigation
assembly.
(2) Vehicle speed sensor
Used to calculate the vehicle running distance.
NS
NS–7
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(c) GPS navigation (Satellite navigation)
This method detects the absolute vehicle position
using radio waves from a GPS satellite.
* GPS satellites were launched by the U.S.
Department of Defence for military purposes.
Current longitude/latitude/altitude is determined using the radio wave arrival time from four satellites.
GPS
I100029E03
Number of satellites
Measurement
Description
2 or less
Measurement impossible
Vehicle position cannot be obtained because
the number of satellites is not enough.
3
2-dimensional measurement is possible
Vehicle position is obtained based on the
current longitude and latitude. (This is less
precise than 3-dimensional measurement.)
4
3-dimensional measurement is possible
Vehicle position is obtained based on the
current longitude, latitude and altitude.
NS
NS–8
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(d) Map matching
The current driving route is calculated by
autonomous navigation (according to the gyro
sensor and vehicle speed sensor) and GPS
navigation. This information is then compared with
possible road shapes from the map data in the map
disc and the vehicle position is set onto the most
appropriate road.
Start
Actual driving route
Driving route on the display
(Route by estimation)
L1
L 1
A
L 2
L2
L3
Roads
L 3
The system compares the shape of the roads L1,
L2 and L3 to the estimated running track after the
vehicle makes a right turn. At point A, the vehicle
position differs enough from the shape of L1 that
the display switches to the road L2.
Map
Matching
NS
I100030E07
NS–9
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(e) Touch switch
Touch switches are touch-sensitive (interactive)
switches operated by touching the screen. When a
switch is pressed, the outer glass bends in to
contact the inner glass at the pressed position. By
doing this, the voltage ratio is measured and the
pressed position is detected.
Outer
Glass
Inner
Vx1 (Vy1)
Vy1
Contact
Vx1
Vx2
Vx2 (Vy2)
Vy2
Touch-sensitive switch position
The touch switch detects the voltage ratio
and calculates the position on the screen.
E106414E03
3.
DVD (Digital Versatile Disc) player outline (for
navigation map)
(a) The radio and navigation assembly (built-in
navigation ECU) uses a laser pickup to read the
digital signals recorded on a DVD.
HINT:
• Do not disassemble any part of the radio and
navigation assembly (built-in navigation ECU).
• Do not apply oil to the radio and navigation
assembly (built-in navigation ECU).
• Do not insert anything but a DVD into the radio
and navigation assembly (built-in navigation
ECU).
NS
NS–10
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4.
CAUTION:
Do not look directly at the laser pickup because
the radio and navigation assembly (built-in
navigation ECU) uses an invisible laser beam.
Be sure to only operate the navigation system
as instructed.
CD (Compact Disc) player outline
(a) A compact disc player uses a laser pickup to read
digital signals recorded on a compact disc (CD). By
converting the digital signals to analog, it can play
music and other things.
NOTICE:
• Do not disassemble any part of the CD player.
• Do not apply oil to the CD player.
• Do not insert anything but a CD into the CD
player.
CAUTION:
Do not look directly at the laser pickup because
the CD player uses an invisible laser beam. Be
sure to only operate the player as instructed.
(b) Usable discs
(1) This player can only play audio CDs, CD-Rs
(CD-Recordable), and CD-RWs (CDReWritable) that have any of the following
marks:
E119759
NS
(c) Precautions for use of discs
NOTICE:
• Copy-protected CDs cannot be played.
• CD-Rs and CD-RWs may not be played
depending on the recording conditions or
characteristics of the discs, or due to
damage, dirt, or deterioration caused by
leaving the discs in the cabin for a long time.
• Unfinalized CD-Rs and CD-RWs cannot be
played.
• Dualdiscs that mate DVD recorded material
on one side with CD digital audio material on
the other cannot be played.
• Keep the discs away from dirt. Be careful not
to damage the discs or leave your
fingerprints on them.
• Hold discs by the outer edge and center hole
with the label side up.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–11
• Leaving the disc exposed halfway out of the
slot for a long time after pressing the disc
eject button may cause deformation of the
disc, making the disc unusable.
• If discs have adhesive tape, stickers, CDR
labels, or any traces of such labels attached,
the discs may not be ejected or player
malfunctions may result.
• Keep the discs away from direct sunlight.
(Exposure to direct sunlight may cause
deformation of the disc, making the disc
unusable.)
• Do not use odd-shaped CDs because these
may cause player malfunctions.
• Do not use discs whose recording portion is
transparent or translucent because they may
not be inserted, ejected, or played normally.
HINT:
• When it is cold or it is raining, if the windows mist
up, mist and also dew may form in the player. In
such a case, the CD may skip or the CD may
stop in the middle of play. Ventilate or dehumidify
the cabin for a while before using the player.
• The CD may skip if the player experiences strong
vibrations when the vehicle is driven on rough
road or similar uneven surface(s).
I100151
5.
(d) Cleaning
NOTICE:
Do not use a lens cleaner because it may cause
a malfunction in the pickup portion of the player.
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a
soft dry cloth such as an eyeglass cleaner for
plastic lenses from the inside to the outside in a
radial direction.
NOTICE:
• Pressing on the disc by hand or rubbing
the disc with a hard cloth may scratch the
disc surface.
• Use of solvent such as a record spray,
antistatic agent, alcohol, benzine, and
thinner, or a chemical cloth may cause
damage to the disc, making the disc
unusable.
MP3 / WMA OUTLINE
(a) Playable MP3 file standards
Compatible standard
Compatible sampling frequency
Compatible bit rate
Compatible channel mode
MP3 (MPEG1 LAYER3, MPEG2 LSF LAYER 3)
•
•
MPEG1 LAYER3: 32, 44.1, 48 (kHz)
MPEG2 LSF LAYER3: 16, 22.05, 24 (kHz)
•
MPEG1 LAYER3: 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 160, 192, 224, 256, 320
(kbps)
MPEG2 LSF LAYER3: 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 144, 160 (kbps)
Compatible with VBR
•
•
Stereo, joint stereo, dual channel, monaural
NS
NS–12
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) Playable WMA file standards
Compatible standard
WMA Ver. 7, 8, and 9
Compatible sampling frequency
32, 44.1, 48 (kHz)
Compatible bit rate
•
•
•
Ver. 7, 8: CBR48, 64, 80, 96, 128, 160, 192 (kbps)
Ver. 9: CBR48, 64, 80, 96, 128, 160, 192, 256, 320 (kbps)
Compatible with playback of channel 2 only
(c) ID3 tag and WMA tag
(1) Additional textual information called ID3 tag can
be input to MP3 files. Information such as song
titles and artist names can be stored.
HINT:
This player is compatible with the ID3 tags of ID3
Ver. 1.0 and 1.1, and ID3 Ver. 2.2 and 2.3.
(Number of characters complies with ID3 Ver.
1.0 and 1.1.)
(2) Additional textual information called WMA tag
can be input to WMA files. Information such as
song titles and artist names can be stored.
(d) Usable media
(1) Only CD-ROMs, CD-Rs (CD-Recordable), and
CD-RWs (CD-ReWritable) only can be used to
play MP3/WMA files.
NOTICE:
• CD-Rs and CD-RWs are more easily
affected by a hot and humid environment
than discs used for normal audio CDs. For
this reason, some CD-Rs and CD-RWs
may not be played.
• If there are fingerprints or scratches on
the disc, the disc may not be played or the
CD may skip.
• Some CD-Rs and CD-RWs deteriorate if
they are left in the cabin for a long time.
• Keep CD-Rs and CD-RWs in a storage
case that is impenetrable to light.
(e) Usable media format
(1) Usable media format
NS
Disc format
CD-ROM Mode 1, CD-ROM XA Mode 2 Form 1
File format
ISO9660 Level 1 and Level 2 (Joliet, Romeo)
HINT:
• As for MP3/WMA files written in any format
other than those above, the contents of the
files may not be played normally or the file
names or folder names may not be displayed
correctly.
• This player is compatible with multi-session
discs and can play CD-Rs and CD-RWs on
which MP3/WMA files are added. However,
only the first session can be played.
• Discs whose first session includes both music
data and MP3 or WMA format data cannot be
played.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–13
(2) Standard and restrictions
Maximum directory levels
8 levels
Maximum number of characters for a folder name/file name
16 two-byte characters (or 32 one-byte characters)
Maximum number of folders
192 (Including empty folders, route folders, and folders that do not
contain MP3 / WMA files)
Maximum number of files in a disc
255 (Including non-MP3 / WMA files)
(f)
6.
File names
(1) Only files with an extension of ".mp3" or ".wma"
can be recognized and played as MP3 or WMA
files.
(2) Save MP3 or WMA files with an extension of
".mp3" or ".wma".
NOTICE:
If saving non-MP3 or non-WMA files with an
extension of ".mp3" or ".wma", those files
are wrongly recognized as MP3 orWMA files
and played. A loud noise may occur and
damage to the speaker may result.
AVC-LAN Description
(a) What is AVC-LAN?
AVC-LAN, an abbreviation for "Audio Visual
Communication Local Area Network", is a united
standard developed by the manufacturers in
affiliation with Toyota Motor Corporation. This
standard pertains to audio and visual signals as well
as switch and communication signals.
Example:
Radio Receiver (Resistor 60 to 80 Ω)
AVC-LAN
Stereo Component Amplifier
I100032E09
NS
NS–14
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
7.
8.
NS
(b) Purpose:
Recently, car audio systems have rapidly developed
and the functions have vastly changed. The
conventional car audio system is being integrated
with multi-media interfaces similar to those in
navigation systems. At the same time, customers
are demanding higher quality from their audio
systems. This is merely an overview of the
standardization background. The specific purposes
are as follows:
(1) To solve sound problems, etc. caused by using
components of different manufacturers through
signal standardization.
(2) To allow each manufacturer to concentrate on
developing products they do best. From this,
reasonably priced products can be produced.
HINT:
• If a short to +B or short to ground is detected
in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is
interrupted and the audio system will stop
functioning.
• If an audio system is equipped with a
navigation system, the multi-display unit acts
as the master unit.
If the navigation system is not equipped, the
audio head unit acts as the master unit
instead. If the radio and navigation assembly
is equipped, it is the master unit.
• The radio and navigation assembly contains
a resistor that is necessary to enable
communication on the different AVC-LAN
circuits.
• The car audio system with an AVC-LAN
circuit has a diagnostic function.
• Each component has a specified number (3digit) called a physical address. Each function
has a number (2-digit) called a logical
address.
Communication system outline
(a) Components of the navigation system communicate
with each other via the AVC-LAN.
(b) The radio and navigation assembly has enough
resistance (60 to 80 Ω) necessary for
communication.
(c) If a short circuit or open circuit occurs in the AVCLAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the
navigation system will stop functioning.
Diagnostic function outline
(a) The audio system has a diagnostic function (the
result is indicated on the master unit).
(b) A 3-digit hexadecimal component code (physical
address) is allocated to each component on the
AVC-LAN. Using this code, the component in the
diagnostic function can be displayed.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
9.
E100921
Example:
NS–15
"Bluetooth" outline
(a) "Bluethooth" is a trademark owned by Bluetooth
SIG. Inc.
(b) "Bluetooth" is a new wireless connection technology
that uses the 2.4 GHz frequency band. This makes
it possible to connect a cellular phone ("Bluetooth"
compatible phone *1) to the radio and navigation
assembly (the "Bluetooth" system is built in), and
use the handsfree function of the cellular phone,
even if it is in a pocket or bag. As a result, it is not
necessary to use a connector attached directly to
the cellular phone.
*1: Some versions of "Bluetooth" compatible cellular
phones may not function.
Radio and Navigation Assembly
(Built-in Bluetooth receiver antenna)
Cellular Phone (Bluetooth type)
Cellular Tower
E121227E01
HINT:
The communication performance of "Bluetooth"
may vary depending on obstructions or radio wave
conditions between communication devices,
electromagnetic radiation, communication device
sensitivity, or antenna capacity.
NS
NS–16
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT INTO A WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
DIAGNOSTIC QUESTIONING AND SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a) Ask the customer about symptoms and confirm
malfunctions.
THE SCREEN DISPLAYS NOTHING (GO TO
STEP 8, AND PROCEED TO "BLACK
SCREEN")
OTHER SYMPTOMS (GO TO STEP 3)
3
CONFIRM THE SYSTEM NORMAL CONDITION
APPLICABLE (THIS IS NOT A
MALFUNCTION)
NOT APPLICABLE (GO TO STEP 4)
4
CHECK DTC
HINT:
If the system cannot enter the diagnosis mode, inspect each
AVC-LAN communication signal and repair or replace
problem parts.
A CODE IS OUTPUT (GO TO STEP 5)
A CODE IS NOT OUTPUT (GO TO STEP 8)
5
DTC CLEAR
(a) Clear the DTCs and finish the diagnostic mode.
HINT:
The currently output DTCs may not indicate actual
malfunctions depending on the vehicle conditions.
NEXT
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
6
NS–17
RECHECK DTC
HINT:
• If the system cannot enter the diagnosis mode, inspect the
AVC-LAN and all the components that connect to the AVCLAN for short circuits.
• Even if the malfunction symptom is not confirmed, check
for diagnostic trouble codes. This is because the system
stores past diagnostic trouble codes.
• Refer to the detailed description on the diagnostic screen,
as necessary (See page NS-30).
• Check the diagnostic trouble code and inspect the area
the code indicates.
A CODE IS OUTPUT (GO TO STEP 7)
A CODE IS NOT OUTPUT (GO TO STEP 8)
7
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(a) Find the output code on the diagnostic trouble code
chart.
NEXT
8
GO TO STEP 10
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Find the applicable symptom code in the problem
symptoms table.
HINT:
If the symptom does not recur and no code is output,
perform the symptom reproduction method (See page
NS-41).
THERE IS AN APPLICABLE SYMPTOM
CODE IN THE TABLE (GO TO STEP 10)
THERE IS NO APPLICABLE SYMPTOM
CODE IN THE TABLE (GO TO STEP 9)
9
CHECK THE ECU TERMINAL ARRANGEMENT BASED ON THE MALFUNCTION
SYMPTOM
NEXT
10
CHECK THE CIRCUIT
(a) Adjust, repair, or replace as necessary.
NS
NS–18
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NEXT
11
RECHECK THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
HINT:
After deleting the DTCs, recheck for diagnostic trouble codes.
NEXT
12
NEXT
END
NS
PERFORM CONFIRMATION TEST
NS–19
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
IDENTIFICATION OF NOISE SOURCE
1.
Frequency
300 kHz
30 kHz
Designation
Radio Description
(a) Radio frequency band
(1) Radio broadcasts use the radio frequency bands
shown in the table below.
LF
MF
Modulation
HF
VHF
FM
Amplitude modulation
MF: Medium Frequency
300 MHz
30 MHz
AM
Radio Wave
LF: Low Frequency
30 MHz
HF: High Frequency
Frequency modulation
VHF: Very High Frequency
E108734E01
(b) Service area
(1) The service areas of AM and FM broadcasts are
vastly different. Sometimes an AM broadcast
can be received very clearly but an FM stereo
cannot. FM stereo has the smallest service area,
and is prone to pick up static and other types of
interference such as noise.
(c) Radio reception problems
HINT:
In addition to static, other problems such as
"phasing", "multipath", and "fade out" exist. These
problems are not caused by electrical noise, but by
the radio signal propagation method itself.
FM (Stereo)
FM (Monaural)
AM
E108735E01
Phasing
Ionosphere
(1) Phasing
AM broadcasts are susceptible to electrical
interference and another kind of interference
called phasing. Occurring only at night, phasing
is the interference created when a vehicle
receives 2 radio wave signals from the same
transmitter. One signal is reflected off the
ionosphere and the other signal is received
directly from the transmitter.
I100011E02
NS
NS–20
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(2) Multipath
Multipath is a type of interference created when
a vehicle receives 2 radio wave signals from the
same transmitter. One signal is reflected off
buildings or mountains and the other signal is
received directly from the transmitter.
Multipath
I100012E02
(3) Fade out
Fade out is caused by objects (buildings,
mountains, and other large obstacles) that
deflect away part of a signal, resulting in a
weaker signal when the object is between the
transmitter and vehicle. High frequency radio
waves, such as FM broadcasts, are easily
deflected by obstructions. Low frequency radio
waves, such as AM broadcasts, are much more
difficult to deflect.
(d) Noise problem
Technicians must have a clear understanding about
each customer's noise complaint. Use the following
table to diagnose noise problems.
Fade Out
I100013E02
Radio Frequency
Noise Occurrence Condition
Presumable Cause
AM
Noise occurs in a specified area
Foreign noise
AM
Noise occurs when listening to an intermittent broadcast
An identical program transmitted from
multiple towers can cause noise where the
signals overlap
AM
Noise occurs only at night
Music beat from a distant broadcast
FM
Noise occurs while driving in a specified area
Multipath or phasing noise resulting from a
change in FM frequency
HINT:
If the noise does not match the examples above, refer to the
descriptions about phasing and multipath.
NS
NS–67
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-D6
No Master
DTC
01-D7
Connection Check Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-D6
*1
When either of the following conditions is met:
• The component which has stored the code has
(had) been disconnected when the ignition switch is
in the ACC or ON position.
• The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is stored.
01-D7
*2
When either of the following conditions is met:
• The component which has stored the code has
(had) been disconnected after the engine starts
(started).
• The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Radio and navigation assembly power source
circuit
Power source circuit of the component which has
stored this code
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
Component which has stored this code
Radio and navigation assembly
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
engine start voltage.
• *2: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio and navigation assembly is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
Refer to the radio and navigation assembly power source
circuit (See page NS-229).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
NS
NS–68
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Example:
Display
Component
Rr-TV
Television display assembly
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
Component which has
stored this code
DTC
E121199E01
NEXT
3
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component which
has stored this code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
NS
Proceed to
Television display assembly (Rr-TV)
Television display assembly power source circuit (See page NS-231)
Stereo component amplifier (DSP-AMP)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (See page NS-227)
NEXT
NS–69
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R12-5) ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio and
navigation assembly and the component which has
stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio and navigation assembly and the
component which has stored this code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS
NS–70
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
6
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Replace the component which has stored this code with
a normal one and check if the same problem occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–71
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-DC
Transmission Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
01-DC
*1
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Transmission to component shown by sub-code failed.
(Detecting this DTC does not always mean actual
failure.)
If the same sub-code is recorded in other components,
check harness for power supply and communication
system of all components shown by code
HINT:
*1: This code may be stored if the engine is started, idled for 60 seconds and then the ignition switch is
turned to the START position again.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio and navigation assembly is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK FOR DTC OF OTHER COMPONENTS
(a) Check if the component shown by the sub-code is
displayed in the check result of the other components.
(1) Check if "01-DC" is output for the other
components.
(2) If "01-DC" is output for any other components,
check if the same physical address is displayed.
HINT:
For the list of the components shown by sub-codes,
refer to the table in step 2.
Result
Result
Proceed to
"01-DC" is output and the same physical address is
displayed
A
"01-DC" is not output or the same physical address
is not displayed
B
B
Go to step 4
A
NS
NS–72
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Example:
Display
Component
Rr-TV (1B0)
Television display assembly
DSP-AMP (440)
Stereo component amplifier
AVN (140)
Radio and navigation assembly
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
Component which has
stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E121199E02
NEXT
3
CHECK COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Select the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Component
Radio and navigation assembly (AVN)
Radio and navigation assembly communication error (See page NS-221)
Television display assembly (Rr-TV)
Television display assembly communication error (See page NS-224)
Stereo component amplifier (DSP-AMP)
Stereo component amplifier communication error (See page NS-218)
NEXT
NS
Proceed to
END
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
NS–73
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
HINT:
If "01-DC" is output for only one component, this may not
indicate a malfunction.
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
END
NS
NS–1
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
NAVIGATION
PARTS LOCATION
OVERHEAD J/B
RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
- MICROPHONE
FRONT CENTER SPEAKER
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
- FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
TELEVISION DISPLAY
ASSEMBLY (*1)
- FRONT STEREO
COMPONENT SPEAKER
STEREO JACK ADAPTER
WINDOW GLASS
ANTENNA WIRE
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
- FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
ENGINE ROOM R/B
- ACC CUT RELAY
- AM1 FUSE
- ALT FUSE
REAR SPEAKER
NO. 1 SPEAKER WITH BOX
- EFI FUSE
- WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
- RADIO NO. 1 FUSE
- RADIO NO. 2 FUSE
COMBINATION METER
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
- DOME FUSE
STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
E120049E01
NS
NS–2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Steering Pad Switch
Combination Meter
Vehicle Speed Signal
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Built-in
Woofer Box
Speaker)
Speakers
Park / Neutral Position Switch
Reverse Signal
Parking Brake Switch
Parking Brake Signal
Microphone Assembly
Microphone Voice Signal
Radio and
Navigation
Assembly
Stereo Jack Adapter
External Device Sound Signal
Radio Antenna GPS Antenna
(*1)
*1: with Rear Seat
Entertainment System
Television
Display
Assembly (*1)
(*1)
(*1)
: Display Signal
: Sound Signal
: AVC-LAN
E120050E04
NS
NS–74
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-DD
Master Reset
DTC
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
01-DD
*1
DTC Detection Condition
The device that should be the master has been
disconnected after the engine starts.
Trouble Area
•
•
01-E1
*2
The AMP device records that the AMP output does not
function even while the source device is operating.
•
•
Radio and navigation assembly power source
circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
Radio and navigation assembly
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
• *1: This code may be stored if the engine is started and the ignition switch is turned to the START
position again.
• *2: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
engine start voltage.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio and navigation assembly is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
Refer to the radio and navigation assembly power source
circuit (See page NS-229).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
NS
NS–75
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R12-5) ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
NS
NS–76
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Example:
Display
Component
Rr-TV
Television display assembly
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
E111829E03
NEXT
4
NS
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio and
navigation assembly and the component which has
stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio and navigation assembly and the
component which has stored this code.
NS–77
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the radio and navigation assembly with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
OK
END
NS
NS–78
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-DF
Master Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
01-DF
*1
•
The device with a display fails and the master is
switched to the audio device.
A communication error between sub-master (radio
receiver) and master occurs.
•
•
•
•
Radio and navigation assembly power source
circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the radio receiver
Radio and navigation assembly
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*1: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio and navigation assembly is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
Refer to the radio and navigation assembly power source
circuit (See page NS-229).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
NS
NS–79
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R12-5) ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
NS
NS–80
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component Table:
Example:
Display
Component
Rr-TV
Television display assembly
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
Component which has
stored this code
DTC
E121199E04
NEXT
4
NS
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio and
navigation assembly and the component which has
stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio and navigation assembly and the
component which has stored this code.
NS–81
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the radio and navigation assembly with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
OK
END
NS
NS–82
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication Error
DTC
01-E3
Registration Demand Transmission
DTC
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-E0
"Registration complete" signal from the master device
cannot be received.
-
01-E3
The registration demand signal from the slave device is
output. Or the registration demand signal is output by
receiving connection confirmation signal from the submaster device.
-
01-E4
The multiple frame transmission is incomplete.
-
HINT:
Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or engine
start voltage.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
• These DTCs do not indicate a malfunction.
NS
NS–83
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
01-E2
DTC Detection Condition
The signal for ON/OFF control from the master device
has a problem.
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NEXT
END
NS
NS–84
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
21-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
21-11
Touch Switch Error
DTC
23-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
23-11
Touch Switch Error
DTC
24-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
24-11
Touch Switch Error
DTC
25-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
25-11
Touch Switch Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
21-10
DTC Detection Condition
21-11
The touch panel switch has a problem.
23-10
The panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
23-11
The touch panel switch has a problem.
24-10
The panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
24-11
The touch panel switch has a problem.
25-10
The panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
25-11
The touch panel switch has a problem.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
NS
Trouble Area
The panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
Radio and navigation assembly
NS–85
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
34-10
Error in Picture Circuit
DTC
34-11
No Current in Back-light
DTC
34-12
Excess Current in Back-light
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
34-10
Error in power supply system for picture circuit
34-11
Decline in power output from inverter circuit for backlight
34-12
Excess power output from inverter circuit for back-light
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NEXT
END
NS
NS–86
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-10
DVD Player Mechanical Error
DTC
44-11
DVD Insertion and Ejection Error
DTC
44-12
DVD Reading Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
TC No.
DTC Detection Condition
44-10
A mechanical error in the DVD player is detected while
the DVD is not being inserted or ejected.
44-11
DVD insertion or ejection is failed.
44-12
DVD read problem occurs.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
NS
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
Trouble Area
Television display assembly
NS–87
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
44-42
Disc cannot be Read
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
44-41
An unsuitable disc is inserted.
44-42
The disc cannot be read.
Trouble Area
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
2
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
antistatic preservative.
I100151
NEXT
3
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
NS
NS–88
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
5
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
NS–89
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-43
DVD-ROM Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
44-43
DTC Detection Condition
DVD-ROM operation is abnormal.
Trouble Area
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK IF A PROPER DVD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the DVD is a video DVD or a CD with an
MP3 file, and that it is not deformed, flawed, stained,
burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal DVD or CD
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped DVDs or CDs cannot
be played.
• For details on playable DVDs or CDs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
NG
DISC IS FAULTY
OK
2
CHANGE DISC
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–90
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-44
DVD Error
DTC
44-48
Excess Current
DTC
44-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
44-44
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Operation error in the DVD mechanism
44-48
Excess current is present in the DVD player.
44-50
Malfunction in insertion/ejection system
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the television
display assembly.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
NS–91
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-45
Eject Error
DTC
44-51
Elevator Error
DTC
44-52
Clamp Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
44-45
Disc cannot be ejected.
44-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator operation.
44-52
Error occurs in DVD player clamp.
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Check if a disc can be changed, inserted or ejected
normally.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–92
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
44-46
Scratches or dirt is found on DVD surface or DVD is set
upside down.
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK THAT DISC IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check whether or not the disc is inserted upside down.
OK:
Disc is properly inserted.
NG
REINSERT DISC
OK
2
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
3
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
I100151
NS
NEXT
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
NS–93
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
6
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–94
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-47
High Temperature
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
44-47
Sensor detects that DVD unit temperature is high (Over
80°C).
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the television display
assembly has become sufficiently low, and start the
engine. Check that the malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
NS–95
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-78
DSP Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
44-78
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
An error occurs during the decode process (MP3 /
WMA).
-
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
NOTICE:
• This code may be output even if there is no malfunction.
• If this code is output frequently, replace the television display assembly.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–21
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM NORMAL CONDITION CHECK
1.
CHECK NORMAL CONDITION
(a) If the symptom is applicable to any of the following,
it is intended behavior, and not a malfunction.
Symptom
Answer
A longer route than expected is chosen.
Depending on the road conditions, the radio and navigation assembly
may determine that a longer route is quicker.
Even when distance priority is high, the shortest route is not shown.
Some paths may not be advised due to safety concerns.
When the vehicle is put into motion immediately after the engine
starts, the navigation system deviates from the actual position.
If the vehicle starts before the navigation system activates, the system
may not react.
When running on certain types of roads, especially new roads, the
vehicle position deviates from the actual position.
When the vehicle is driving on new roads not available on the map
disc, the system attempts to match it to another nearby road, causing
the position mark to deviate.
(b) The following symptoms are not a malfunction, but
are caused by errors inherent in the GPS, gyro
sensor, speed sensor, and radio and navigation
assembly.
(1) The current position mark may be displayed on a
nearby parallel road.
I100066
(2) Immediately after a fork in the road, the current
vehicle position mark may be displayed on the
wrong road.
I100067
(3) When the vehicle turns right or left at an
intersection, the current vehicle position mark
may be displayed on a nearby parallel road.
I100068
NS
NS–22
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(4) When the vehicle is carried, such as on a ferry,
and the vehicle itself is not running, the current
vehicle position mark may be displayed in the
position where the vehicle was until a
measurement can be performed by GPS.
I100069
(5) When the vehicle runs on a steep hill, the
current vehicle position mark may deviate from
the correct position.
I100070
(6) When the vehicle makes a continuous turn of
360, 720, 1,080, etc. degrees, the current
vehicle position mark may deviate from the
correct position.
I100071
(7) When the vehicle moves erratically, such as
constant lane changes, the current vehicle
position mark may deviate from the correct
position.
I100072
(8) When the ignition switch is turned to the ACC or
ON position on a turntable before parking, the
current vehicle position mark may not point in
the correct direction. The same will occur when
the vehicle comes out of parking.
NS
I038146
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–23
(9) When the vehicle runs on a snowy road or a
mountain path with the chains installed or using
a spare tire, the current vehicle position mark
may deviate from the correct position.
I100074
(10)When a tire is changed, the current vehicle
position mark may deviate from the correct
position.
HINT:
• Diameter of the tire may change, causing a
speed sensor error.
• Performing the "tire change" in calibration
mode will allow the system to correct the
current vehicle position faster.
I100075
NS
NS–96
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
44-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
44-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
44-7F
Copyright Protection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
An incompatible MP3/WMA file is used.
Although the file has an extension of ".mp3" or
".wma", the header information cannot be read.
44-7E
•
•
A disc with no music data is used.
Playable files are not on the disc (MP3/WMA).
44-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
44-7D
•
•
DVD
Television display assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHANGE DISC
(a) Insert a disc with a playable file and check if the disc can
be played correctly.
HINT:
For details on playable files and discs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
OK:
The disc can be played correctly.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
NS–97
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
57-47
Bluetooth Module Initialization Failed
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
57-47
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
•
Bluetooth module is not installed.
Problem with Bluetooth module
Problem in communication line to Bluetooth module
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NEXT
END
NS
NS–98
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-10
Gyro Error
DTC
80-10
Gyro Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
58-10
Ground short, power supply short, or open circuit in the
gyro signal
80-10
Ground short, power supply short, or open circuit in the
gyro signal
•
•
Gyro sensor
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(See page NS-27).
(b) Check the gyro voltage.
Standard voltage:
0.1 to 4.5 V
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
E120088
OK
2
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
3
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the radio and
navigation assembly.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–99
OK
END
NS
NS–234
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION RECEIVER
NAVIGATION RECEIVER
BODY ELECTRICAL
NAVIGATION
COMPONENTS
RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
CONSOLE UPPER
REAR PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER
W/ NAVIGATION:
RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
RADIO NO. 2
BRACKET
NS
RADIO NO. 1
BRACKET
E115638E02
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION RECEIVER
NS–235
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE (See
page IP-6)
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-8)
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
(See page IP-7)
6.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-7)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER (See page IP-8)
8.
REMOVE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY (w/
Bracket)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Disconnect the connectors and remove the radio
and navigation assembly w/ bracket.
9.
REMOVE RADIO NO. 1 BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 screws and radio No. 1 bracket.
E133061
I033306
10. REMOVE RADIO NO. 2 BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 screws and radio No. 2 bracket.
I033040
NS
NS–100
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-11
GPS Receiver Error
DTC
80-11
GPS Receiver Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
58-11
•
•
80-11
•
RTC, ROM, and RAM of the GPS receiver and
TCXO error
GPS receiver is failed.
RTC, ROM, and RAM of the GPS receiver and
TCXO error
GPS receiver is failed.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
NS–101
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-40
GPS Antenna Error
DTC
58-41
GPS Antenna Power Source Error
DTC
80-40
GPS Antenna Error
DTC
80-41
GPS Antenna Power Source Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-40
GPS antenna error
58-41
Error of the power source to the GPS antenna
80-40
GPS antenna error
80-41
Error of the power source to the GPS antenna
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
GPS antenna
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (GPS ANTENNA - RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check that the GPS antenna cord is securely connected
to the radio and navigation assembly connector.
OK:
The cord is securely connected.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
REPLACE GPS ANTENNA
(a) Replace the GPS antenna with a normal one and check
if the same problem occurs again.
(1) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(2) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–102
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-42
Map Disc Read Error
DTC
80-42
Map Disc Read Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-42
•
•
•
Player error
Scratches or dirt on the disc
Access to an invalid address due to software error
80-42
•
•
•
Player error
Scratches or dirt on the disc
Access to an invalid address due to software error
Trouble Area
•
•
Map disc
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the map disc.
NG
Go to step 4
I100152
OK
2
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to the outside in a radial
direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
I100201E04
NEXT
NS
3
DTC CLEAR AND RECHECK
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–103
(b) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
OK
END
NG
4
REPLACE MAP DISC
(a) Replace the map disc.
(b) Clear the DTCs and recheck for DTCs.
(c) Check if the same trouble occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
OK
END
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–104
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-43
SPD Signal Error
DTC
80-43
SPD Signal Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
58-43
A difference between the GPS speed and SPD pulse is
detected.
80-43
A difference between the GPS speed and SPD pulse is
detected.
•
•
Speed signal circuit
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(See page NS-27).
(b) While driving the vehicle, compare the "SPD" indicator to
the reading on the speedometer. Check if these readings
are almost equal.
OK:
The readings are almost equal.
OK
E120089
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Refer to "Speed signal does not change in the navigation
check mode" in the problem symptoms table (See page NS41).
NEXT
END
NS
NS–105
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-44
Player Error
DTC
80-44
Player Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-44
Map player error is detected.
80-44
Map player error is detected.
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check if a disc can be inserted or ejected normally.
OK:
A disc can be inserted or ejected normally.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
2
DTC CLEAR AND RECHECK
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(b) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
OK
END
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–106
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-45
High Temperature
DTC
80-45
High Temperature
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
58-45
High map disc player temperature is detected (Over
80°C).
80-45
High map disc player temperature is detected (Over
80°C).
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the radio and navigation
assembly has becomes sufficiently low, then start the
engine to verify the malfunction symptom.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–107
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
5C-40
Camera Picture Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Synchronous signal from the camera cannot be
transmitted.
5C-40
Wire harness
Television camera assembly
Radio and navigation assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
T11
Television Camera Assembly
CV+
CGND
Radio and Navigation Assembly
4
22
R26 V+
2
21
R26 CGND
24
R26 CA+
CB+ 1
CV-
3
(*1)
(*1)
(*1)
(*1)
23
R26 V-
*1: Shielded
E120090E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the R26 connector from the radio and
navigation assembly.
(b) Disconnect the T11 connector from the television camera
assembly.
NS
NS–108
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Radio and Navigation Assembly:
R26
Television Camera Assembly:
CGND
CB+
T11
CA+
V- V+
CGND
CV-
CV+
E120091E01
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
CB+ (T11-1) - CA+ (R26-24)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CGND (T11-2) - CGND (R26-21)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CV+ (T11-4) - V+ (R26-22)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CV- (T11-3) - V- (R26-23)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CB+ (T11-1) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
CGND (T11-2) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
CV+ (T11-4) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
CV- (T11-3) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector.
NS
NS–109
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Television Camera Assembly:
CGND
CB+
T11
E126215E01
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
CB+ (T11-1) - CGND (T11-2)
IG SW ON, shift lever R position
Approx. 6 V
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
3
INSPECT TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the radio and navigation assembly R26
connector and the television camera assembly T11
connector.
NS
NS–110
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Television Camera Assembly:
T11
CV+
CV-
E120092E01
(b) Check the waveform of the television camera assembly
using an oscilloscope.
(1) Measurement terminal: CV+ - CVMeasurement setting: 0.2 V/DIV, 0.2 µs/DIV
Condition: Ignition switch ON, Shift lever in R range
OK:
Pulses as shown in the illustration.
GND
NG
E119731E02
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
REPLACE TELEVISION CAMERA
ASSEMBLY
NS–111
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-10
CD Changer Mechanical Error
DTC
63-11
CD Insertion and Ejection Error
DTC
63-12
CD Reading Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
63-10
A mechanical error in the CD changer is detected while
the CD is not being inserted or ejected.
63-11
CD insertion or ejection is failed.
63-12
CD read problem occurs.
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NEXT
END
NS
NS–112
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
63-42
Disc cannot be Read
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
63-41
An unsuitable disc is inserted.
63-42
The disc cannot be read.
Trouble Area
•
•
CD
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
2
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
anti-static preservative.
I100151
NEXT
3
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NS
NEXT
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
NS–113
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
5
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–114
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
63-43
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
CD-ROM operation is abnormal.
CD
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK IF A PROPER CD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the CD is an audio CD or a CD with an
MP3 or WMA file, and that it is not deformed, flawed,
stained, burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal CD
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped CDs cannot be
played.
• CD with adhesive paper labels should not be played.
• Commercial audio CDs can be played.
• CD-DA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs can
be played.
• MP3 and WMA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CDRWs can be played.
• For details on playable CDs, refer to the Owner's
Manual.
NG
CD IS FAULTY
OK
2
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the CD with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the CD with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
NS
END
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–115
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-44
CD Abnormal
DTC
63-48
Excess Current
DTC
63-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
63-44
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Operation error in the CD mechanism
63-48
Excess current is present in the CD changer.
63-50
Malfunction in insertion/ejection system
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the radio and
navigation assembly.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–116
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-45
Eject Error
DTC
63-51
Elevator Error
DTC
63-52
Clamp Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
63-45
Magazine cannot be ejected.
63-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator operation.
63-52
Error occurs in CD changer clamp.
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check if a disc can be changed, inserted, or ejected
normally.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–117
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
63-46
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Scratches or dirt is found on CD surface or CD is set
upside down.
•
•
CD
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK THAT CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check that the CD is not inserted upside down.
OK:
CD is properly inserted.
NG
INSERT CD PROPERLY
OK
2
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
3
DISC CLEANING
(a) Disc cleaning
(1) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft
cloth from the inside to outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100151
NEXT
NS
NS–118
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
6
REPLACE DISC WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with another normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–119
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-47
High Temperature
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
63-47
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Sensor detects that CD unit temperature is high (Over
80°C).
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the radio and navigation
assembly becomes sufficiently low, then start the engine.
Check that the malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–120
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-78
DSP Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
63-78
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
An error occurs during the decode process (MP3 /
WMA).
-
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection completed, clear the DTCs.
NOTICE:
• This code may be output even if there is no malfunction.
• If this code is output frequently, replace the radio and navigation assembly.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (See page NS-49).
HINT:
These DTCs do not indicate a malfunction.
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–24
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DISPLAY CHECK MODE
HINT:
• This mode checks the color display on the display.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (See page NS-49)
2.
DISPLAY CHECK
(a) Select "Display Check" from the "Diagnosis MENU"
screen.
3.
COLOR BAR CHECK
(a) Select "Color Bar Check" from the "Display Check"
screen.
E120055E02
E120053E07
(b) Select a color bar from the "Color Bar Check Mode"
screen.
(c) Check the display color.
HINT:
• The entire screen turns to the color or stripe
selected.
• Touching the display will return to the "Color Bar
Check" screen.
NS
E120102
NS–25
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4.
TOUCH SWITCH CHECK
(a) Select "Touch Switch Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
E125809E02
(b) Touch the display anywhere in the open area to
perform the check when the "Touch Switch Check"
screen is displayed.
HINT:
• A "+" mark is displayed where the display is
touched.
• The "+" mark remains on the display even after
the finger is removed.
E120103
5.
PANEL SWITCH CHECK
(a) Select "Panel Switch Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
E125809E03
(b) Operate each switch and check that the switch
name and condition are correctly displayed.
*1
*2
*3
I100041E07
Display
Push switch name/*1
Rotary switch name/*2
Rotary switch direction/*3
Contents
•
•
Name of the pressed switch is displayed.
If more than one switch is pressed, "MULTIPLE" is displayed.
Name of the rotary switch is displayed.
Direction of the rotary switch is displayed.
NS
NS–26
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
6.
VEHICLE SIGNAL CHECK
(a) Select "Vehicle Signal Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
E125809E04
(b) When the "Vehicle Signal Check Mode" screen is
displayed, check all the vehicle signal conditions.
HINT:
• Only conditions having inputs are displayed.
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• For details of this function, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page
NS-30).
E125810
7.
E120057
NS
CAN CHECK
(a) Select "CAN check" from the "Display check"
screen.
(b) Check the CAN connection check result.
HINT:
• This function operates only for the systems
connected to the CAN system.
• For details of this function, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page
NS-30).
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–27
BLUETOOTH TEL CHECK MODE
HINT:
Illustration may differ from the actual vehicle depending on
the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed
area may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual
vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (See page NS-49)
2.
"BLUETOOTH" TEL CHECK
(a) Select ""Bluetooth" TEL Check" from the "Diagnosis
MENU" screen.
3.
"BLUETOOTH" CHECK
(a) Select ""Bluetooth" Check" from the ""Bluetooth"
Handsfree Check Menu" screen.
E120062E01
E120063
(b) Select "Serial Communication Log" from the
""Bluetooth" Check Menu" screen.
E120064
(1) The communication log data in the display ECU
are displayed on this screen.
HINT:
The displayed data can be used as a reference.
E120065
NS
NS–28
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(c) Select "Software Version" from the ""Bluetooth"
Check Menu" screen.
E120066
(1) Check the software version of the "Bluetooth"
module.
*1
*2
*3
*4
E120067E02
Screen Description:
Display
Contents
General Version / *1
•
•
General software version of "Bluetooth" module
If any of the API version, upper stack version, and low stack
version is updated, the general version is upgraded.
API Version / *2
API software version is displayed.
Upper Stack Version / *3
Upper Stack version is displayed.
Lower Stack Version / *4
Lower Stack version is displayed.
HINT:
This function is controlled by the built-in display
ECU.
4.
E120068
NS
HANDSFREE VOICE QUALITY SET
(a) Select "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" from the
""Bluetooth" Handsfree check Menu" screen.
NS–29
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) Check the handsfree voice level.
*1
*2
E120069E01
Screen Description:
Display
Contents
Received voice level adjustment / *1
Setting possible for the voice level received from "Bluetooth"
compatible phones.
Sent voice level adjustment / *2
Setting possible for the voice set to "Bluetooth" compatible phones.
HINT:
This function is controlled by the built-in display
ECU.
NOTICE:
"Voice Quality Type" should not be changed.
NS
NS–121
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
63-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
63-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
63-7F
Copyright Protection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
•
An incompatible MP3 / WMA file is used.
Although the file has an extension of ".mp3" or
".wma", the header information cannot be read.
63-7E
•
•
A disc with no music data is used.
Playable files are not on the disc (MP3 / WMA).
63-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
63-7D
•
•
CD
Radio and navigation assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHANGE DISC
(a) Insert a disc with a playable file and check if the disc can
be played correctly.
HINT:
For details on playable files and discs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
OK:
The disc can be played correctly.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
DISC IS FAULTY
NS
NS–122
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Noise Occurs
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
NOISE CONDITION
(a) Check in which direction the noise comes from (front left
or right, or rear left or right).
(1) Check in which direction the noise comes from.
OK:
The location of the noise source can be
determined.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
CHECK SPEAKERS
(a) Check the installation conditions of the speaker units that
are located near the noise source and that there are no
cracks, scratches, deformation, or other failures.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
A speaker is installed incorrectly
A
Foreign objects are in the speaker
B
A speaker cone paper is broken
C
No malfunction is found
D
A
REINSTALL SPEAKER
B
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT
C
REPLACE SPEAKER
D
3
CHECK NOISE CONDITIONS
(a) Check the noise condition.
HINT:
The radio has a noise prevention function to reduce
noise when listening to the radio. If a loud noise occurs,
check whether the ground at the antenna mounting base
and the noise prevention unit are installed and wired
correctly.
Conditions under which noise occurs
NS
Noise increases when the accelerator pedal is depressed, but stops when the engine is stopped.
Noise occurs during A/C or heater operation.
Noise occurs when the vehicle accelerates rapidly on an unpaved road or after the ignition switch
is turned ON or ACC.
Noise Source
Generator
Blower motor
Fuel pump
NS–123
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Conditions under which noise occurs
Noise Source
Noise occurs when the horn switch is pressed and released or when pressed and held.
Horn
Noise occurs synchronously with the blink of the turn signal.
Flasher
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Washer
Noise occurs while the engine is running, and continues even after the engine is stopped.
Noise occurs during wiper operation.
Water temperature sensor
Wiper
Noise occurs when the brake pedal is depressed.
Stop light switch
Others
Static electricity
HINT:
• In the chart's left column, find the situation that
matches the customer's complaint. Then, in the right
column, find the part that is causing the noise. Check
the noise filter on or for the part.
• To save time and avoid a misdiagnosis, first make
sure that the noise is not coming from outside the
vehicle.
• Noise should be removed in descending order of
loudness.
• Setting the radio to a frequency where no signal is
received may make recognition of the noise problem
easier.
OK:
The noise source can not be determined.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NOISE SOURCE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–124
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Pressing Power Switch does not Turn on System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check that conditions in the cabin are not likely to cause
condensation.
HINT:
This problem occurs when the cabin is humid and the
temperature rapidly changes. This condition may
produce condensation, resulting in a short circuit.
OK:
Condensation is not likely to occur.
NG
DRY CABIN AND RECHECK CONDITIONS
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–125
No Sound can be Heard from Speakers
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUDIO SETTINGS
(a) Enter the sound adjustment screen by pressing the
"SOUND" switch on the AUDIO display.
(b) Set volume, fader, and balance to the initial values and
check that sound is normal.
OK:
Audio system returns to normal.
HINT:
Sound quality adjustment items vary depending on the
type of the amplifier.
E120098
OK
END
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ANTENNA
NS–237
NAVIGATION ANTENNA
BODY ELECTRICAL
NAVIGATION
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSEMBLY
B120192E06
NS
NS–238
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ANTENNA
NAVIGATION ANTENNA
NS
E115640E02
NS–126
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CD cannot be Ejected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Press the disc eject switch of the radio receiver for 5
seconds or more and check that the CD is ejected.
OK:
CD is ejected.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
2
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Insert another CD and check if it is ejected.
OK:
CD is ejected.
NG
OK
CD IS FAULTY
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–127
CD cannot be Inserted / Played or CD is Ejected Right After Insertion
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK IF A PROPER CD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the CD is an audio CD or a CD with an
MP3 or WMA file, and that it is not deformed, flawed,
stained, burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal CD
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped CDs cannot be
played.
• Commercial audio CDs can be played.
• CD-DA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs can
be played.
• MP3 and WMA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs and CDRWs can be played.
• For details on playable CDs, refer to the Owner's
Manual.
NG
CD IS FAULTY
OK
2
CHECK THAT CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check whether or not the CD is inserted upside down.
OK:
CD is properly inserted.
NG
SET CD PROPERLY
OK
3
CHECK CD
(a) Clean the disc by wiping it with a soft cloth from the
inside to the outside in a radial direction.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
antistatic preservative.
OK
CD WAS DIRTY
I100151
NG
NS
NS–128
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
(a) Replace the CD with a normal one and check that the
malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
CD IS FAULTY
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–129
CD Sound Skips
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CD
(a) Check the CD.
OK:
The CD is clean.
HINT:
If dirt is on the CD surface, wipe it clean with a soft cloth
from the inside to the outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100151
NG
CLEAN CD
OK
2
CHECK CD
(a) Check that the CD is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the CD.
NG
CD IS FAULTY
I100152
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION USING ANOTHER CD
(a) Check using another CD.
(1) Check if the problem recurs using another CD.
OK:
The problem does not occur.
OK
CD IS FAULTY
NG
4
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the radio and navigation assembly installation
condition.
(1) Check that the radio and navigation assembly is
properly installed.
NS
NS–130
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK:
Radio and navigation assembly is properly
installed.
NG
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
REINSTALL RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–131
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Radio Broadcast cannot be Received or Poor Reception
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the radio's automatic station search function.
(1) Check the radio's automatic station search function
by activating it.
OK:
The radio's automatic station search function
works properly.
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R12.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ANT - Body ground
Ignition SW ON
Radio SW ON
10 to 14 V
NG
R12
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
ANT
E120099E02
OK
3
CHECK OPTIONAL COMPONENTS
(a) Check optional components (sun-shade film, telephone
antenna, etc.).
(1) Check if any optional components, such as
sunshade film or telephone antenna that may
decrease reception capacity, are installed.
OK:
Optional components are installed.
NOTICE:
Do not remove any optional components
installed by the customer without his or her
consent.
NS
NS–132
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
REMOVE AND RECHECK OPTIONAL
COMPONENTS (SEE NOTICE ABOVE)
NG
4
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
E050367E01
(a) Preparation for check
(1) Remove the antenna plug from the radio and
navigation assembly.
(b) Check for noise
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position with the
radio and navigation assembly connector
connected.
(2) Turn the radio on and put into AM mode.
(3) Place a screwdriver, thin wire, or other metal object
on the radio receiver's antenna jack and check that
noise can be heard from the speaker.
OK:
Noise occurs.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
5
CHECK GLASS ANTENNA
(a) Check for continuity of the antenna.
HINT:
Check for continuity at the center of each antenna wire
as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, wipe it in the direction of
the wire with a soft dry cloth. Take care not to
damage the wire. Do not use detergents or glass
cleaners with abrasive ingredients. When measuring
voltage, wrap a piece of tin foil around the tip of the
negative probe and press the foil against the wire
with your finger, as shown in the illustration.
OK:
There is continuity in the antenna.
Tester Probe
Tin Foil
Antenna Wire
NG
E111994E02
NS
OK
REPAIR GLASS ANTENNA
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
6
NS–133
REPLACE ANTENNA AMPLIFIER
(a) Replace the antenna amplifier and check that it operates
normally.
OK:
The antenna amplifier operates normally.
OK
END
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–134
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Illumination for Panel Switch does not Come on with Tail Switch ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE SIGNAL (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Vehicle Signal Check
Mode) (See page NS-22).
(b) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the light control switch operation.
OK
Light Control Switch
I038223E01
TAIL or ON
ON
OFF
OFF
HINT:
This display is updated once per second. As a result, it is
normal for the display to lag behind the actual change in
the switch.
NG
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
Display
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–135
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Display does not Dim when Light Control Switch is Turned ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK IMAGE QUALITY SETTING
(a) Enter the display adjustment screen by pressing the
"DISPLAY" switch.
(b) Turn the light control switch to the TAIL position.
(c) Check if "DAY MODE" on the display adjustment is ON.
OK:
"DAY MODE" is ON.
NG
Go to step 2
E125813
OK
TURN "DAY MODE" SETTING OFF
2
CHECK VEHICLE SIGNAL (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Vehicle Signal Check)
(See page NS-22).
(b) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the light control switch operation.
OK
Light Control Switch
E125810E01
Display
TAIL or ON
ON
OFF
OFF
HINT:
The display is updated once per second. It is normal for
the display to lag behind the actual switch operation.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–136
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Panel Switches do not Function
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK PANEL SWITCH
(a) Check for foreign matter around the switches that might
prevent operation.
OK:
No foreign matter is found.
NG
REMOVE ANY FOREIGN MATTER FOUND
OK
2
CHECK PANEL SWITCH (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Panel Switch Check)
(See page NS-22).
(b) Operate the abnormal switch and check if the switch
name and status are correctly displayed.
OK:
The switch name and status are correctly
displayed as operated.
NG
I100041
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–137
Touch Panel Switch does not Function
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TOUCH PANEL
(a) Check for foreign matter on the display.
OK:
The display is clean.
NG
CLEAN DISPLAY AND RECHECK TOUCH
PANEL
OK
2
CHECK TOUCH SWITCH (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Touch Switch Check)
(See page NS-22).
(b) Touch the display in the area where the switch
malfunction occurs.
OK:
A "+" mark appears at the touched position.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
I100039E04
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–138
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Display Panel does not Open, Tilt or Tilts Improperly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check for foreign matter or obstructions caught in the
moving parts of the panel.
OK:
No obstruction or foreign matter found.
NG
REMOVE ANY OBSTRUCTION OR FOREIGN
MATTER FOUND
E120094
OK
2
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Check if the navigation and audio systems function
properly.
OK:
Navigation and audio systems function properly.
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–139
Screen Flicker or Color Distortion
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DISPLAY SETTING
(a) Enter the display adjustment screen by pressing the
"DISPLAY" switch.
(b) Reset display settings (contrast, brightness) and check
that the screen appears normal.
E120095
(c) Press the "INFO" switch and then select "Screen
Setting."
E120096E03
(d) Set the "Switch Color" to "Green" (initial setting) and
check if the display returns to normal.
OK:
Returns to normal.
NG
Go to step 2
E120097
OK
END
2
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check that the cabin temperature is warmer than -20°C
(-4.0°F).
OK:
Cabin is warmer than -20°C (-4.0°F).
NG
HEAT CABIN AND RECHECK
TEMPERATURE
NS
NS–140
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK COLOR BAR (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Color Bar Check) (See
page NS-22).
(b) Check that the color bars match the displayed names.
OK:
Color bars match the displayed names.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
I100037E05
OK
4
CHECK NAVI COLOR BAR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (NAVI Color Bar
Check) (See page NS-27).
(b) Check that the color bars match the displayed names.
OK:
Color bars match the displayed names.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
I100050E04
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–141
Poor Sound Quality in All Modes (Low Volume)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUDIO SETTINGS
(a) Set "BASS", "MID" and "TREB" to the initial values and
check that sound is normal.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
2
COMPARE WITH ANOTHER VEHICLE OF SAME MODEL
(a) Compare with another vehicle of the same model.
(1) Compare with another vehicle of the same model
which does not have trouble to see if there is any
difference in the sound quality.
OK:
No difference is found.
OK
END
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–142
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
MAP Disc cannot be Inserted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check if a disc is inserted into the MAP disc slot.
(1) Check if "DISC IN" is displayed.
OK:
"DISC IN" is displayed.
NG
EJECT DISC
E125111
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–143
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Position Mark Deviates Greatly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK GPS MARK
(a) Check that the GPS mark is displayed.
OK:
GPS mark is displayed.
NG
GO TO "GPS MARK IS NOT DISPLAYED" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
E125110E01
OK
2
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(See page NS-27).
(b) While driving the vehicle, compare the "Speed" indicator
to the reading on the speedometer. Check that these
readings are almost equal.
OK:
The readings are almost equal.
NG
E120089
GO TO "SPEED SIGNAL DOES NOT
CHANGE IN NAVIGATION CHECK MODE" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
3
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the shift lever operation (P and R).
OK
E120101E01
Shift Lever Position
Display
P
OFF
R
ON
HINT:
The display is updated once per second. It is normal for
the display to lag behind the actual switch operation.
NG
GO TO "REVERSE SIGNAL DOES NOT
CHANGE IN NAVIGATION CHECK MODE" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–144
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–30
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE
HINT:
• This mode displays GPS satellite information.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (See page NS-49 )
2.
NAVIGATION CHECK
(a) Select "Navigation Check" from the "Diagnosis
MENU" screen.
3.
GPS INFORMATION
(a) Select "GPS Information" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
E120058E01
E120059E15
(b) When GPS information is displayed, check the GPS
conditions.
HINT:
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• For details of this function, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page
NS-30).
I102403
4.
NS
E120059E16
VEHICLE SENSORS
(a) Select "Vehicle Sensors" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–31
(b) Check all the signals and sensors when vehicle
signal information is displayed.
HINT:
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• This screen displays vehicle signals input to the
built-in navigation ECU.
• For details of this function, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page
NS-30).
E120060
5.
COLOR BAR CHECK
(a) Select "Color Bar Check" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
E120059E17
(b) Check each color of the color bar when the "NAVI
Color Bar Check" screen is displayed.
HINT:
• Colors will not be displayed full-screen as in
"Display Check Mode".
• This screen displays the built-in navigation ECU
display color.
I100050
6.
MEMORY COPY/PASTE CHECK
HINT:
This function cannot be used.
7.
PARTS INFORMATION
(a) Select "Parts Information" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
E120059E18
NS
E120059E19
NS–32
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) Check the navigation and disc information when the
"Parts Information" screen is displayed.
*1
*2
*3
*4
I100052E02
Screen Description:
Display
Contents
Navigation Manufacturer/*1
Radio and navigation assembly manufacturer is displayed.
Navigation Version/*2
Radio and navigation assembly version is displayed.
Disc Manufacturer/*3
Map disc manufacturer is displayed.
Disc Version/*4
Map disc version is displayed.
8.
MIC & VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK
(a) Select "Mic & Voice Recognition Check" on the
"Display Check" screen to display "MICROPHONE
& VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK" screen.
E120059E20
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Stop Switch
Recording
Indicator
E120056E04
NS
(b) When voice is input into the microphone, check that
the microphone input level meter changes
according to the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice
recording.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played
normally.
HINT:
• For details of this function, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page
NS-30).
• This function is controlled by the built-in
navigation ECU.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
9.
NS–33
DVD PLAYER INFORMATION CHECK
(a) Select "DVD Player Information" from the
"Navigation Check" screen.
E120059E21
(b) Check for DTCs.
HINT:
• This is a DVD player check function in the radio
and navigation assembly (built-in navigation
ECU).
• For details of this function, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page
NS-30).
Trouble code
E120061E01
NS
NS–34
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS DISPLAY DETAILED
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• This section contains a detailed description of displays
within diagnostic mode.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
1. SYSTEM CHECK
(a) System Check Mode Screen
*1
*2
*3
*1
*2
*4
I100055E08
(1) Device Names and Hardware Address/*1
HINT:
• Registered device names are displayed.
• If a device name is unknown to the system,
its physical address is shown instead.
Address No.
NS
Name
Address No.
Name
110
EMV
120
AVX
128
1DIN TV
140
AVN
144
G-BOOK
178
NAVI
17C
MONET
190
AUDIO H/U
1AC
CAMERA-C
1B0
Rr-TV
1C0
Rr-CONT
19D
BT-HF
1C4
PANEL
1C6
G/W
1C8
FM-M-LCD
1D8
CONT-SW
1EC
Body
118
EMVN
1F1
XM
1F2
SIRIUS
230
TV-TUNER
240
CD-CH2
250
DVD-CH
280
CAMERA
360
CD-CH1
3A0
MD-CH
NS–35
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Address No.
17D
Name
Address No.
TEL
440
Name
DSP-AMP
530
ETC
1F6
RSE
1A0
DVD-P
1D6
CLOCK
238
DTV
480
AMP
(2) Check Result/*2
HINT:
Result codes for all devices are displayed.
Result
Meaning
Action
OK
The device did not respond with a DTC
(excluding communication DTCs from the
AVC-LAN).
EXCH
The device responds with a "replace"-type
DTC.
Look up the DTC in "Unit Check Mode" and
replace the device.
CHEK
The device responds with a "check"-type
DTC.
Look up the DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NCON
The device was previously present, but does
not respond in diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the
device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
Old
The device responds with an "old"-type DTC.
Look up the DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
The device responds in diagnostic mode, but
gives no DTC information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the
device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
NRES
-
(3) Code Clear/*3
• Present DTCs are cleared.
• Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3 seconds.
(4) Memory Clear/*4
• Present and past DTCs and registered
connected device names are cleared.
• Press the "Memory CLR" switch for 3
seconds.
(b) Diagnosis MENU Screen
NS
E120070E01
NS–36
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on
the device settings.
(c) Unit Check Mode Screen
*1
*6
*5
*2
*3
*4
*7
E120071E03
Screen Description:
Display
Device name/*1
Segment/*2
DTC/*3
Timestamp/*4
Present Code/*5
Past Code/*6
Diagnosis Clear Switch/*7
NS
Contents
Target device
Target device logical address
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
The time and date of past DTCs are displayed. (The year is displayed
in 2-digit format.)
DTCs output at the service check are displayed.
Diagnostic memory results and recorded DTCs are displayed.
Pushing this switch for 3 seconds clears the diagnostic memory data
of the target device. (Both response to diagnostic system check result
and the displayed data are cleared.)
NS–37
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(d) LAN Monitor (Original) Screen
*1
I100058E04
(1) Check Result/*1
HINT:
Check results of all the devices are displayed.
Result
No Err (OK)
Meaning
There are no communication DTCs.
Action
-
CHEK
The device responds with a "check"-type
DTC.
Look up the DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NCON
The device was previously present, but does
not respond in diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the
device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
The device responded with an "old"-type
DTC.
Look up the DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
The device responds in diagnostic mode, but
gives no DTC information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the
device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
Old
NRES
NS
NS–38
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(e) LAN Monitor (Individual) Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
*7
*6
E120072E01
Screen Description:
Display
Device name/*1
Segment/*2
DTC/*3
Sub-code (device address)/*4
Connection check No./*5
DTC occurrence/*6
Diagnosis Clear Switch/*7
NS
Contents
Target device
Target logical address
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
Physical address stored with DTC (If there is no address, nothing is
displayed.)
Connection check number stored with DTC
Number of times the same DTC has been recorded
Pushing this switch for 3 seconds clears the diagnostic memory data
of the target device. (Both response to diagnostic system check result
and the displayed data are cleared.)
NS–39
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2.
DISPLAY CHECK
(a) Vehicle Signal Check Mode Screen
E120073
Screen Description:
Name
Battery
Contents
Battery voltage is displayed.
PKB
Parking brake ON/OFF state is displayed.
REV
Reverse signal ON/OFF state is displayed.
IG
TAIL
SPEED
IG switch ON/OFF state is displayed.
TAIL signal (Light control switch) ON/OFF state is displayed.
Vehicle speed is displayed in km/h.
HINT:
• Only items sending a vehicle signal will be
displayed.
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
NS
NS–40
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) CAN Connection Check Screen
*1
E120075E01
Screen Description:
Name
Contents
•
•
CAN Connection check result/*1
•
•
For systems connected to the CAN system, the results of the CAN
connection check are displayed.
"NG" - The ignition switch is ACC or ON and the CAN
communication lines are malfunctioning or the CAN bus lines are
not connected.
"OK" - The ignition switch is ACC or ON and the CAN
communication lines are normal.
Blank - CAN connection check is performed with the ignition
switch is ACC or off.
HINT:
• This function operates only for the systems
connected to the CAN system.
• When the ignition switch is turned off, the bus
lines are disconnected, or a malfunction occurs
in the bus lines while the CAN connection check
result is being displayed, the problem will be
reflected on the screen in real time.
HINT:
When the ignition switch is turned off, the bus lines
are disconnected, or a malfunction occurs in the bus
lines while the CAN connection check result is being
displayed, the problem will be reflected on the
screen in real time.
NS
NS–41
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3.
NAVIGATION CHECK
(a) Navigation Check Screen
E120076E01
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on
the device settings.
(b) GPS Information Screen
*1
*1
*2
*2
*5
*3
*4
I102405E01
(1) Satellite information/*1
Information from a maximum of 12 satellites is
displayed on the screen. This information
includes the target GPS satellite number,
elevation angle, direction, and signal level.
NS
NS–42
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(2) Receiving condition/*2
(DENSO model):
Display
Contents
T
The system is receiving a GPS signal, but is not using it for location.
P
The system is using the GPS signal for location.
-
The system cannot receive a GPS signal.
(AISIN AW model):
Display
Contents
01H
The system cannot receive a GPS signal.
02H
The system is tracing a satellite.
03H
The system is receiving a GPS signal, but is not using it for location.
04H
The system is using the GPS signal for location.
Measurement information/*3:
Display
Contents
2D
2-dimensional location method is being used.
3D
3-dimensional location method is being used.
NG
Location data cannot be used.
Error
-
Reception error has occurred.
Any other state.
Position information/*4
Display
Contents
Position
Latitude and longitude information on the current position is displayed.
Display
Contents
Date information/*5:
Date
The date/time information obtained from GPS signal is displayed in
Greenwich mean time (GMT). The last 4 digits are displayed.
(c) Vehicle Sensors Screen
*1
*2
*3
NS
E120077E01
NS–43
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle signal:
Display
Contents
REV/*1
REV signal ON/OFF state is displayed.
SPD/*2
SPD signal condition is displayed.
Sensor signal:
Display
Contents
Gyro sensor output condition is displayed (when the vehicle runs
straight or is stationary, the voltage is approximately 2.5 V).
Gyro sensor/*3
HINT:
Signals are updated once per second only when
vehicle sensor signals are changed.
(d) Microphone & Voice Recognition Check Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
E125119E01
Screen Description:
Display
Microphone input level meter/*1
Contents
Monitors the microphone input level every 100 ms and displays the
results in 8 different levels.
Recording switch/*2
Starts recording.
Stop switch/*3
Stops recording.
Play switch/*4
Plays the recorded voice.
Recording indicator/*5
Comes on while recording.
HINT:
• The microphone input function is on at all times
when this screen is displayed.
• While recording or playing, the switches other
than the stop switch cannot be pushed.
• When no voice is recorded, the play switch
cannot be pushed.
• Recording will stop after 5 seconds or by pushing
the stop switch.
NS
NS–44
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(e) DVD Player Information Screen
*2
*1
*3
*4
*5
E120078E01
Screen Description:
Display
Contents
Trouble code/*1
Each code corresponding to the malfunctions is displayed. For details,
refer to "Trouble Code Description".
•
Occurrence time/*2
•
The date (year, month, day) and time (hour, minute, second) when
the trouble code was detected are displayed as a time stamp.
(Greenwich mean time)
The time data to be displayed are received from the GPS receiver.
All code data being displayed are cleared by pushing this switch for 3
seconds.
Trouble code clear switch/*3
Returning switch/*4
The previous page is displayed. If the current displayed page is the
first page, this switch cannot be operated.
Proceeding switch/*5
The next page is displayed. If the current displayed page is the last
page, this switch cannot be operated.
Trouble Code Description:
Code
01
03
Malfunction
Countermeasure
Cannot be recognized
Replace radio and navigation assembly.
Cannot be read
Follow the inspection procedure for DTC 58-42 (See
page NS-97).
HINT:
This is a DVD player check function in the radio and
navigation assembly (built-in navigation ECU).
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–145
Cursor or MAP Rotates when Vehicle Stopped
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONDITION
(a) Check with the customer if the vehicle has been turned
by a turntable.
OK:
Vehicle has not been turned by turntable.
HINT:
If the vehicle is turned on a turntable with the ignition
switch on, the system may store the angular velocity. As
a result, the vehicle position cursor may deviate.
E106418
NG
TURN IGNITION SWITCH TO ON POSITION
WHEN VEHICLE IS COMPLETELY STOPPED
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–146
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Position Mark is not Updated
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISPLAY
(a) Check if a touch scroll can be performed on the map
display.
OK:
Touch scroll can be performed.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
3
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(See page NS-27).
(b) While driving the vehicle, compare the "Speed" indicator
to the reading on the speedometer. Check if these
readings are almost equal.
OK:
The readings are almost equal.
NG
E120089
GO TO "SPEED SIGNAL DOES NOT
CHANGE IN NAVIGATION CHECK MODE" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–147
Current Position Display does not Appear
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check if a map disc is inserted into the map disc slot.
OK:
A map disc is inserted.
NG
INSERT MAP DISC IN MAP SIDE SLOT
E125111
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks appear on the map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–148
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
GPS Mark is not Displayed
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check the cabin for any object that might interrupt radio
reception on the instrument panel. If such an object
exists, remove it and check if the GPS mark reappears.
HINT:
The GPS uses extremely faint radio waves originating
from satellites. If the signal is interrupted by obstructions
or other radio waves, the GPS may not be able to
properly receive the signal.
OK:
Mark appears.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
2
CHECK SURROUNDINGS
(a) Check if the vehicle is in a location where GPS signal
reception is poor. If the vehicle is in such a place,
relocate the vehicle and check if the GPS mark
reappears.
HINT:
The GPS uses 24 satellites in 6 orbits. At any point in
time, 4 satellites should be able to pinpoint your vehicle.
However, GPS signals may not reach the vehicle due to
influence from the surroundings, vehicle direction, and
time. For illustrated examples, see below.
NS
NS–149
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
In a tunnel
In a building
Under an overpass
Between tall buildings
On a forest or tree-lined path
Under a cliff, overhang
I100196E03
OK:
GPS mark is displayed.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
SYSTEM RETURN TO NORMAL
3
CHECK GPS INFORMATION (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
I102403E01
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (GPS Information)
(See page NS-27).
(b) Check how many of the following codes appear in the
"STS" column.
For DENSO Made:
T, P
For AISIN AW Made:
08H, 04H
OK:
At least 3 codes appear.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–150
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–151
Voice Guidance does not Function
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK NAVIGATION SYSTEM SETTING
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Volume".
E120104E02
(c) Check that "OFF" is not selected.
OK:
"OFF" is not selected.
NG
TURN VOICE GUIDANCE VOLUME UP TO 4
USING VOICE ADJUSTMENT SWITCHES
E120106
OK
2
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTING
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Set up".
E120104E03
NS
NS–152
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(c) Check that "Voice Guidance in All Modes" is not OFF.
OK:
Voice guidance in all modes is not OFF.
NG
TURN VOICE GUIDANCE IN ALL MODES
"ON"
E120105E01
OK
3
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTING
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Setup".
E120104E03
(c) Check that "Auto Voice Guidance" is not OFF.
OK:
Auto voice guidance is not OFF.
NG
TURN AUTO VOICE GUIDANCE "ON"
E120107
OK
4
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
NS
I100152E12
REPLACE MAP DISC
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–153
OK
5
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that audio sound can be heard from the driver
side speaker.
OK:
Audio sound can be heard.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–154
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
MAP Display Incomplete
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
2
CHECK DISPLAY
(a) Check that displays other than the navigation display are
complete.
OK:
No other incomplete displays are found.
OK
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–155
Route cannot be Calculated
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
2
SET DESTINATION
(a) Set another destination and check if the system can
calculate the route correctly.
OK:
Route can be correctly calculated.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NS
NS–156
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Voice Recognition Difficulty
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONDITION
(a) Check if the system's voice recognition level is low by
using only one particular voice.
OK:
System's voice recognition level is low with any
voice.
NG
SYSTEM'S VOICE RECOGNITION LEVEL
VARIES DEPENDING ON VOICE AND
PRONUNCIATION. THIS IS NOT A
MALFUNCTION.
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
3
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check for dirt on the map disc surface.
OK:
No dirt is on map disc surface.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
HINT:
If the disc is dirty, clean the disc by wiping the disc's
surface radially with a soft cloth.
I100201E04
OK
NS
NG
CLEAN MAP DISC
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
NS–157
CHECK MICROPHONE (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Recording
Indicator
Stop Switch
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (See page NS-27).
(b) When voice is input into the microphone, check that the
microphone input level meter changes according to the
input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
Voice can be recorded up to 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
E120056E03
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
END
NS
NS–158
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Voice is not Recognized
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTINGS
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Setup".
E120104E03
(c) Check that "Voice Recognition Guidance" is not OFF.
OK:
Voice Recognition Guidance is not OFF.
NG
TURN VOICE RECOGNITION GUIDANCE
"ON"
E120105E02
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
I100152E12
OK
NS
REPLACE MAP DISC
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3
NS–159
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check for dirt on the map disc surface.
OK:
No dirt is on the map disc surface.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
HINT:
If the disc is dirty, clean the disc by wiping the disc's
surface radially with a soft cloth.
I100201E04
NG
CLEAN MAP DISC
OK
4
CHECK MICROPHONE (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Recording
Indicator
Stop Switch
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (See page NS-27).
(b) When voice is input into the microphone, check that the
microphone input level meter changes according to the
input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
Voice can be recorded up to 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
E120056E03
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–160
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cellular Phone Registration Failure, Phone Directory Transfer Failure
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CURRENT CONDITIONS
(a) Proceed to the next step according to the table below.
RESULT
Conditions
Proceed To
Another "Bluetooth" compatible cellular phone is present.
A
Another "Bluetooth" compatible vehicle is present.
B
None of the above
C
B
Go to step 3
C
Go to step 4
A
2
CHECK USING ANOTHER CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the system functions using another "Bluetooth"
compatible cellular phone.
HINT:
• Confirm that either the same or a different version of
another "Bluetooth" compatible cellular phone
complies with the system.
• Depending on the version, some "Bluetooth"
compatible cellular phones cannot be used.
OK:
The system functions.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
USE A "BLUETOOTH" COMPATIBLE CELLULAR PHONE
3
NS
CHECK USING ANOTHER "BLUETOOTH" COMPATIBLE VEHICLE
(a) Register the cellular phone with another vehicle and
check if the system functions normally.
HINT:
Depending on the version, some "Bluetooth" compatible
cellular phones cannot be used.
OK:
The system functions.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
NS–161
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NG
USE A "BLUETOOTH" COMPATIBLE CELLULAR PHONE
4
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone is "Bluetooth" compatible.
HINT:
Some versions of "Bluetooth" compatible cellular phones
may not function.
OK:
The phone is "Bluetooth" compatible.
NG
USE A "BLUETOOTH" COMPATIBLE
CELLULAR PHONE
OK
5
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if a call can be made from the cellular phone.
HINT:
When the battery is low, registration or directory transfer
cannot be done.
OK:
A call can be made from the cellular phone.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–162
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cellular Phone cannot Send / Receive
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK "BLUETOOTH" SETTINGS
(a) Check if the "Bluetooth" settings are correct.
OK:
"Bluetooth" settings are correct.
NG
SET SETTINGS CORRECTLY
OK
2
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone is "Bluetooth" compatible.
HINT:
Some versions of "Bluetooth" compatible cellular phones
may not function.
OK:
Phone is "Bluetooth" compatible.
NG
END (ONLY A "BLUETOOTH" COMPATIBLE
CELLULAR PHONE CAN BE USED)
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the cellular phone functions.
HINT:
The cellular phone is unable to call under any of the
following conditions.
• The cellular phone is locked.
• The directory is being transferred.
• The line is crossed.
• Transmission is regulated.
• The power is off.
• The cellular phone is not connected to "Bluetooth"
("BT" is displayed while connected).
OK:
None of the above conditions exist.
NG
SET SETTINGS CORRECTLY
OK
4
NS
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone can make a call.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–163
HINT:
When the battery is low, calls cannot be made or
received.
OK:
Cellular phone can make a call.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
5
CHECK RECEPTION
(a) Set the cellular phone so that it can receive calls.
(b) Place the cellular phone close to the radio and
navigation assembly.
(c) Check if the cellular phone has reception according to
the radio and navigation assembly.
OK:
Cellular phone has reception.
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–164
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cannot Call in a Certain Place
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SURROUNDING CONDITIONS
(a) Check if the cellular phone can make calls in a certain
place.
OK:
It can make calls.
NG
END (CELLULAR PHONES CAN ONLY
FUNCTION IN CELLULAR SERVICE AREAS)
OK
2
CHECK RECEPTION
(a) Enter the "Information" screen by pressing the "INFO"
switch.
(b) Select "Telephone".
E120096E02
(c) Check the "Bluetooth" connection indicator (BT
indicator).
E120108E01
Result
NEXT
NS
END
Condition
Procedure
Yellow color
Bring the cellular phone to a location where the BT mark turns
blue.
Blue color
Replace radio and navigation assembly.
No connection mark is displayed
Select a registered cellular phone or register a "Bluetooth"
compatible phone.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–165
The Other Caller's Voice cannot be Heard, is too Quiet, or Distorted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the voice on the other side can be heard using a
cellular phone.
OK:
Voice can be heard.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
2
CHECK NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(a) Check that navigation sound can be heard from the
driver side speaker.
OK:
Audio sound can be heard.
NG
GO TO "VOICE GUIDANCE DOES NOT
FUNCTION" IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the volume level is set to low on the CALL
screen.
OK:
The level is not set low.
NG
SET VOLUME TO HIGH
E120109E02
OK
NS
NS–166
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK SETTINGS
E120069E02
(a) Enter the "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" mode (See page
NS-25).
(b) Check if the Receive Voice Level is set to "0".
HINT:
The Receive Voice Level can be set to 11 different
levels, -5 to +5, with a 3 dB difference.
(c) Check if the Receive Voice Level is set to the minimum
or maximum level.
HINT:
When the Receive Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level, the sound may be distorted.
OK:
The Receive Voice Level is set to "0".
NG
SET RECEIVE VOICE LEVEL TO "0"
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–167
The Other Caller cannot Hear Your Voice, or Your Voice is too Quiet or
Distorted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the other side can hear your voice properly.
OK:
Your voice can be heard correctly.
NG
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
2
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the mute switch is set to ON.
OK:
Mute switch is not set to ON.
NG
TURN MUTE SWITCH OFF
E120109E03
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
E120069E06
(a) Enter the "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" mode (See page
NS-25).
(b) Check if the Send Voice Level is set to "0".
HINT:
The Send Voice Level can be set to 11 different levels, -5
to +5, with a 3 dB difference.
(c) Check if the Send Voice Level minimum or maximum
level.
HINT:
When the Send Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level, the sound may be distorted.
OK:
The Send Voice Level is set to "0".
NG
OK
SET SEND VOICE LEVEL TO "0"
NS
NS–168
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK MICROPHONE (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Recording
Indicator
Stop Switch
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (See page NS-27).
(b) When voice is input into the microphone, check that the
microphone input level meter changes according to the
input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
Voice can be recorded up to 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
E120056E03
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–45
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Before inspecting the suspected areas listed in the table
below, check the fuse and relay.
• Before inspecting the suspected areas listed in the table
below, check the DTCs.
• Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed
in order of probability in the suspected area column.
Display function:
Symptom
Pressing PWR switch does not turn on system.
Black screen (No image appears on navigation/audio
screen).
Illumination for panel switch does not come on with
TAIL switch on.
Display does not dim (Night Screen) with TAIL switch
on.
Power does not turn off (The screen remains on).
Panel switches do not function.
Touch panel switch does not function.
Display panel does not open, tilt, or tilts improperly.
Screen is distorted.
Screen flicker or color distortion.
DVD image cannot be displayed on front screen.
(Parking brake is on.) (*1)
Navigation function switches can be operated while
vehicle is running.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Pressing Power Switch does not Turn ON
System"
NS-119
2. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
3. AVC-LAN circuit
NS-201
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Black Screen"
NS-164
2. Illumination circuit
NS-175
3. AVC-LAN circuit
NS-201
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Illumination for Panel Switch does not Come on
with TAIL Switch ON"
NS-129
2. Illumination circuit
NS-175
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Display does not DIM with Light Control Switch
is Turned ON"
NS-130
2. Illumination circuit
NS-175
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Panel Switches do not Function"
NS-131
2. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-169
3. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Touch Panel Switch does not Function"
NS-132
2. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-169
3. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Display Panel does not Open, Tilt, or Tilts
Improperly"
NS-133
2. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Screen Flicker or Color Distortion"
NS-134
2. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Television
Display Assembly and Radio and Navigation Assembly"
NS-212
2. Parking brake switch circuit
NS-183
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Combination Meter"
NS-165
NS
NS–46
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
Audio function:
Symptom
No sound can be heard from speakers (audio is mute).
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "No Sound can be Heard from Speakers"
NS-120
2. Stereo component amplifier power source circuit
NS-227
3. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Display Assembly" (*1)
NS-197
4. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Stereo Component Amplifier"
NS-199
5. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Stereo Component Amplifier"
NS-193
6. Speaker circuit
NS-185
7. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
8. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
Radio broadcast cannot be received or poor reception.
Proceed to "Radio Broadcast cannot be Received or Poor
Reception"
NS-126
CD cannot be inserted/played or CD is ejected right
after insertion.
Proceed to "CD cannot be Inserted/Played or CD is Ejected
Right After Insertion"
NS-122
CD cannot be ejected.
Proceed to "CD cannot be Ejected"
NS-121
CD sound skips.
Proceed to "CD Sound Skips"
NS-124
Abnormal noise occurs.
Proceed to "Noise Occurs"
NS-117
1. Proceed to "Poor Sound Quality in All Modes (Low Volume)"
NS-136
2. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Display Assembly" (*1)
NS-197
3. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Stereo Component Amplifier"
NS-199
4. Stereo component amplifier power source circuit
NS-227
5. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
6. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
7. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Television display assembly power source circuit
NS-231
2. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Display Assembly"
NS-190
3. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Display Assembly"
NS-197
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
5. Television display assembly
AV-177
1. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Stereo Jack Adapter"
NS-195
2. Stereo jack adapter
AV-191
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Stereo
Component Amplifier and Combination Meter"
NS-203
Poor sound quality in all modes (low volume).
RSE sound cannot be heard or sound quality is bad.
External device sound cannot be heard or sound
quality is bad (Stereo jack is used).
ASL does not function.
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
Navigation function:
Symptom
Map disc cannot be inserted.
NS
Map disc cannot be ejected.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Map Disc cannot be Inserted"
NS-137
2. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
NS–47
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symptom
Vehicle position mark deviates.
Cursor or map rotates when vehicle is stopped.
Vehicle position mark is not updated.
Current position display does not appear.
GPS mark is not displayed.
Voice guidance does not function.
Map display incomplete.
Route cannot be calculated.
Voice recognition difficulty.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Vehicle Position Mark Deviates Greatly"
NS-138
2. GPS antenna
NS-239
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Cursor or Map Rotates When Vehicle is
Stopped"
NS-140
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Vehicle Position Mark is not Updated"
NS-141
2. Map disc
-
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Current Position Display does not Appear"
NS-142
2. Map disc
-
3. GPS antenna
NS-239
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "GPS Mark is not Displayed"
NS-143
2. GPS antenna
NS-239
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Voice Guidance does not Function"
NS-146
2. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Stereo Component Amplifier"
NS-199
3. Navigation Voice Circuit
NS-210
4. Speaker Circuit
NS-185
5. Map disc
-
6. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
7. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
1. Proceed to "Map Display Incomplete"
NS-149
2. Map disc
-
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Route cannot be Calculated"
NS-150
2. Map disc
-
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Voice Recognition Difficulty"
NS-151
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Voice is not Recognized"
NS-153
2. Proceed to "Microphone Circuit between Microphone and
Radio and Navigation Assembly"
NS-215
3. Steering Pad Switch Circuit
NS-169
4. Microphone
AV-201
5. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
Speed signal does not change in the navigation check
mode.
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Combination Meter"
NS-165
Reverse signal does not change in the navigation
check mode.
Proceed to "Reverse Signal Circuit"
NS-207
Voice is not recognized.
Steering pad switch function:
Symptom
Suspected area
See page
The system cannot be operated by the steering pad
switch.
1. Steering Pad Switch Circuit
NS-169
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
Illumination for steering pad switch does not come on
with TAIL switch on.
1. Illumination Circuit
NS-175
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
NS
NS–48
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
"Bluetooth" function:
Symptom
See page
Cellular phone registration failure, phone directory
transfer failure.
Proceed to "Cellular Phone Registration Failure, Phone
Directory Transfer Failure"
NS-155
1. Proceed to "Cellular Phone cannot Send/Receive"
NS-157
Cellular phone cannot send/receive.
2. Steering Pad Switch Circuit
NS-169
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
Cannot call in a certain place.
Proceed to "Cannot Call in a Certain Place"
NS-159
1. Proceed to "The Other Caller's Voice cannot be Heard, is
too Quiet, or Distorted"
NS-160
2. Navigation Voice Circuit
NS-210
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
4. Woofer box speaker assembly (Built-in stereo component
amplifier)
AV-215
1. Proceed to "The Other Caller cannot Hear Your Voice, or
Your Voice is too Quiet or Distorted"
NS-162
2. Proceed to "Microphone Circuit between Microphone and
Radio and Navigation Assembly"
NS-215
The other caller's voice cannot be heard, is too quiet,
or distorted.
The other caller cannot hear your voice, or your voice
is too quiet or distorted.
NS
Suspected area
3. Microphone
-
4. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–169
Black Screen
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DISPLAY SETTING
(a) Check that the display is not in "Screen OFF" mode.
OK:
The display setting is not in "Screen OFF" mode.
NG
CHANGE SCREEN TO "SCREEN ON" MODE
OK
2
CHECK IMAGE QUALITY SETTING
(a) Check that the screen color quality can be set.
OK:
Setting is possible.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
PRESS PANEL SWITCH "DISPLAY" AND SET SCREEN COLOR QUALITY TO NORMAL
3
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check that condensation is not likely to occur in the
cabin, and that the temperature is not high or extremely
low in the cabin.
HINT:
• A humid cabin and a rapid change in temperature
may lead to condensation. Condensation in the cabin
may short circuit the screen.
• The appropriate cabin temperature is 20 to 30°C (68
to 86°F).
OK:
Condensation is not likely and temperature is not
high or extremely low.
NG
SET CABIN TO APPROPRIATE
TEMPERATURE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–170
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly
and Combination Meter
DESCRIPTION
The radio and navigation assembly receives a vehicle speed signal from the combination meter and
information about the GPS antenna, and then adjusts vehicle position.
HINT:
• A voltage of 12 V or 5 V is output from each ECU and then input to the combination meter. The signal
is changed to a pulse signal at the transistor in the combination meter. Each ECU controls the
respective system based on the pulse signal.
• If a short occurs in an ECU, all systems in the diagram below will not operate normally.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio and Navigation Assembly
3
R9
From A/C Control
Assembly
From Moon Roof
Control ECU
SPD
From ECM
From 4WD Control ECU
From Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
5
C9
From Main Body ECU
Combination Meter
From Speed Sensor
E120038E03
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–171
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer on the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9.
(b) Measure the voltage.
(1) Jack up either one of the drive wheels.
(2) Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
SPD
R9
E113510E03
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the
radio and navigation assembly and body ground
when the drive wheels are turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage pulses as shown in the illustration.
OK
4.5 to 14 V
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
Below 2 V
0
Turn the wheel
E110855E01
NG
NS
NS–172
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9 and combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
SPD
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SPD - C9-5
Ignition switch off
Below 1 Ω
NG
R9
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C9-5
E120119E01
OK
NS
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NS–173
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9 and combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
SPD
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SPD - Body ground
Ignition switch off
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the resistance between terminal SPD and body ground
is less than 10 kΩ, there may be a short in a wire
harness, connector, or an ECU.
R9
NG
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR OR CHECK EACH ECU
C9-5
E120119E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
NS
NS–174
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Steering Pad Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends an operation signal from the steering pad switch to the radio and navigation assembly.
If there is an open in the circuit, the navigation system cannot be operated using the steering pad switch.
If there is a short in the circuit, the resulting condition is the same as if the switch were continuously
depressed. Therefore, the radio and navigation assembly cannot be operated using the steering pad
switch, and the radio and navigation assembly itself cannot function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Pad Switch LH
12
AU1
Volume-
Volume+
Seek-
Seek+
A
EAU
MODE
11
AU2
B
B
AU2
EAU
C
C
AU2
AU1
10
A
EAU
Radio and Navigation
Assembly
Spiral Cable
A
12
C13
10
EAU
AU2
C13
11
C13
7
R10 SW1
6
R10 SWG
8
R10 SW2
Steering Pad Switch RH
ON HOOK
OFF HOOK
Voice
E120111E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the airbags. Before
servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure to read the precautionary notice for
the Supplemental Restraint System (See page RS-1).
NS
NS–175
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
1
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R10.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
SW1
SW2
R10
SWG
Tester connection
E113509E02
Condition
Specified condition
SW1 - SWG
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
SW1 - SWG
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
SW1 - SWG
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
SW1 - SWG
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
SW1 - SWG
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
SW2 - SWG
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
SW2 - SWG
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
SW2 - SWG
VOICE switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
SW2 - SWG
ON HOOK switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
SW2 - SWG
OFF HOOK switch:
push
Approx. 1 kΩ
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
2
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch assembly connector
A.
Connector Front View:
A
EAU
AU2
AU1
E120112E01
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
NS
NS–176
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AU1 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU1 - EAU
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU2 - EAU
VOICE switch: push
Approx. 3.1 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
ON HOOK switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
OFF HOOK switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch assembly and spiral
cable connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side:
EAU AU2 AU1
Tester connection
Spiral Cable Position
Specified condition
Center
EAU - EAU
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Center
AU1 - AU1
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Center
AU2 - AU2
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Vehicle Side:
NG
EAU AU2 AU1
NS
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS
airbag system. Incorrect removal or installation of
the spiral cable may prevent the airbag from
deploying. Be sure to read the page shown in the
brackets (See page RS-398).
E113447E03
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
NS–177
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY)
4
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch LH and the steering
pad switch RH.
B
C
21
3
4
5
6
78
12
3
4
5
6
87
E120113E02
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B-1 - C-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-2 - C-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-3 - C-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-4 - C-4
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-5 - C-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-6 - C-6
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-7 - C-7
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-8 - C-8
Always
Below 1 Ω
B-1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-2 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-3 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-4 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-5 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-6 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-7 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B-8 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH CABLE
NS
NS–178
5
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
(a) Reconnect the steering pad switch RH.
Connector Front View:
Opposite Side:
AU2 (B-5)
AU2 (B-4)
B
EAU (B-3)
EAU (B-2)
E120114E01
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
No switch is pushed
10 kΩ or higher
VOICE switch: push
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
ON HOOK switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
OFF HOOK switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-3)
AU2 (B-5) - EAU (B-2)
AU2 (B-4) - EAU (B-3)
NG
NS
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–179
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
NS
NS–180
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Illumination Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Power is supplied to the radio and navigation assembly and steering pad switch illumination when the
light control switch is in the TAIL or HEAD position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Steering Pad Switch
Spiral Cable
LH
1
A
ILL+
1
C13
2
R12 ILL+
10
A
EAU
10
C13
6
R10 SWG
RH
Other Illuminations
TAIL Relay
TAIL
From J/B Fuse
To Main Body ECU
R13 Rheostat
5
E
-
3
12
R12 ILL-
E121201E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NS
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the airbags. Before
servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure to read the precautionary notice for
the Supplemental Restraint System (See page RS-1).
NS–181
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
1
CHECK ILLUMINATION
(a) Check if the illumination for the radio and navigation
assembly, steering pad switch, glove box or others
(hazard switch, cigarette lighter, etc.) comes on when the
light control switch is turned to the HEAD or TAIL
position.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Illumination comes on for all components except steering pad switch.
A
Illumination comes on for all components except radio and navigation assembly.
B
No illumination comes on (radio receiver, hazard switch, glove box, etc.)
C
Illumination comes on only for glove box and steering pad switch.
D
B
Go to step 7
C
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
D
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - SPIRAL CABLE)
Spiral Cable Connector Front View:
C13
(a) Disconnect the spiral connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ILL+ - Body ground
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ILL+
E120026E06
OK
3
CHECK STEERING PAD SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch assembly connector.
NS
NS–182
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
A
+
-
E120115E02
(b) Disconnect the steering pad switch connector.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal ILL+ and the
negative (-) lead to terminal EAU of the steering pad
switch connector.
(d) Check if the illumination for the steering pad switch
comes on.
Result
Proceed to
Illumination comes on for steering pad switch LH and RH.
A
Illumination comes on for only the steering pad switch LH.
B
Illumination comes on for only the steering pad switch RH.
C
B
C
A
NS
Go to step 6
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
NS–183
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch and spiral cable
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side:
ILL+
EAU
Tester Connection
Spiral Cable Position
EAU - EAU
2.5 rotations to the left
Specified Condition
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
Center
ILL+ - ILL+
2.5 rotations to the left
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the right
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS
airbag system. Incorrect removal or installation of
the spiral cable may prevent the airbag from
deploying. Be sure to read the page shown in the
brackets (See page RS-398).
Vehicle Side:
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
EAU
ILL+
E113447E04
OK
NS
NS–184
5
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the radio and navigation
assembly and spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
SWG
R10
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SWG - EAU
Always
Below 1 Ω
SWG - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Spiral Cable Connector Front View:
C13
EAU
E120116E02
OK
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
6
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch LH and the steering
pad switch RH.
NS
NS–185
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
LH
RH
21
3
4
5
6
78
12
3
4
5
6
87
E120113E03
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
LH-1 - RH-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-2 - RH-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-3 - RH-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-4 - RH-4
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-5 - RH-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-6 - RH-6
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-7 - RH-7
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-8 - RH-8
Always
Below 1 Ω
LH-1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-2 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-3 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-4 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-5 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-6 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-7 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
LH-8 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH CABLE
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
NS
NS–186
7
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R12.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
ILL+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ILL+ - Body ground
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
NG
R12
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
E113513E03
OK
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY - LIGHT
CONTROL RHEOSTAT)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly and light
control rheostat connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
ILL-
R12
Condition
Specified condition
ILL- - C13-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
ILL- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Light Control Rheostat
Wire Harness View:
R13
R13-3
NS
Tester connection
E120117E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–187
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–188
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Parking Brake Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is from the parking brake switch to the radio and navigation assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio and Navigation
Assembly
P4
Parking Brake SW
1
R9
1
PKB
E111727E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check that the brake warning light comes on when the
parking brake is applied and goes off when it is released.
OK:
The brake warning light operates as specified
above.
OK
NG
NS
Go to step 3
NS–189
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the parking brake switch.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
ON
OFF
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
Switch connector Switch body
ON (When shaft is not
pressed)
Below 1 Ω
Switch connector Switch body
OFF (When shaft is
pressed)
10 kΩ or higher
E071372E01
NG
REPLACE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PARKING BRAKE SWITCH - RADIO AND
NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9 and parking brake switch connector P4.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
PKB
Tester connection
Condition
PKB - P4-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
PKB - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
R9
Specified condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Parking Brake Switch
Connector Front View:
P4
E120118E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–190
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Speaker Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The sound signal that has been amplified by the stereo component amplifier is sent to the speakers from
the stereo component amplifier through this circuit.
If there is a short in this circuit, the stereo component amplifier detects it and stops output to the speakers.
Thus sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no malfunction in the stereo component
amplifier or speakers.
When a short is detected in the speaker circuit, no sound can be heard from the speakers.
NS
NS–191
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
1
4
S23 RL+
2
13
S23 RL-
1
5
S23 RR+
2
14
S23 RR-
R16
Rear Speaker LH
R17
Rear Speaker RH
S20
Front No. 2 Speaker LH
1
D22
Front No. 1
Speaker LH
2
D23
Front No. 1
Speaker RH
2
4
3
1
S21
Front No. 2 Speaker RH
2
1
2
1
C5
Front Stereo Component
Speaker
Woofer Box Speaker
4
3
4
3
6
S23 FL+
17
S23 FL7
S23 FR+
18
S23 FR3
S23 CTR+
12
S23 CTR-
1
WF+ W4
9
S23 WFR+
3
W4
20
S23 WFR-
2
WF+ W4
8
S23 WFL+
4
W4
19
S23 WFL-
WF-
WF-
E121189E01
NS
NS–192
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
FR+
WFL+
FL+
RR+
RL+
CTR+
WFR+
S23
WFRWFL-
FR- FL-
RR- RL-
CTR-
Front No. 2 Speaker, Front
Stereo Component Speaker
Connector Front View:
S20
S21
C5
Front No. 1 Speaker, Rear
Speaker Connector Front View:
D23
D22
(a) Disconnect the connectors shown in the illustration on
the left from the stereo component amplifier and
speakers.
(b) Measure the resistance between the front No. 2
speakers and the stereo component amplifier to check
for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the resistance between rear speakers and the
stereo component amplifier to check for an open circuit
in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(d) Measure the resistance between the front stereo
component speaker and the stereo component amplifier
to check for an open circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(e) Measure the resistance between the woofer box speaker
and the stereo component amplifier to check for an open
circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(f) Measure the resistance between the front No. 1 speaker
and the front No. 2 speaker to check for an open circuit
in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(g) Measure the resistance between each speaker and body
ground to check for a short circuit in the wire harness.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
NG
R16
R17
Woofer Box Speaker
Connector Front View:
W4
NS
E121190E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NS–193
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1-3
Always
Approximately 1.2 Ω
2-4
Always
Approximately 1.2 Ω
E120044
NG
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
OK
3
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the speaker.
Standard resistance:
4 to 6 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
OK
4
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when another
speaker in good condition is installed.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the front No. 2
speakers.
• When there is a possibility that either right or left front
speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging the
right one with the left one.
OK
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
NG
5
INSPECT REAR SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the speaker.
NS
NS–194
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Approximately 2.6 Ω
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEAKER
OK
6
INSPECT FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
(a) Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the speaker.
Standard resistance:
1.2 to 2.2 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT
SPEAKER
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–195
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly and
Television Display Assembly
DESCRIPTION
The television display assembly sends an RSE sound signal to the radio and navigation assembly through
this circuit. The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier, and then
is sent to the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier, radio and navigation assembly or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display
Assembly
Radio Receiver
1
CSLD R11
CDR+
(Shielded)
27
R18
28
2
R11
R18
3
29
CDR- R11
4
CDL+ R11
5
CDL- R11
SG1
R+
R18 R30
R18
L+
31
R18
L-
E120034E05
NS
NS–196
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the television display
assembly and radio and navigation assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
CDRCDR+
CDL+
CDL-
CSLD
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
CDR+ - R+
Always
Below 1 Ω
R18
Always
Below 1 Ω
Always
Below 1 Ω
CDL- - L-
Always
Below 1 Ω
CSLD - SG1
Always
Below 1 Ω
R- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
L+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R11
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
CDR- - RCDL+ - L+
L- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SG1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
LL+
SG1
R-
R+
E121191E03
OK
2
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the television display assembly connector
and radio and navigation assembly connectors.
(b) Check the waveform according to the conditions in the
table below.
Wire Harness View:
R18
L-
L+ R- R+
NS
E120036E07
NS–197
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R+ - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
R- - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
L+ - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
L- - Body ground
Voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–198
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly and
Stereo Component Amplifier
DESCRIPTION
The radio and navigation assembly sends a sound signal to the stereo component amplifier through this
circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier, and then is sent to
the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
6
SLD
Radio and Navigation Assembly
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
10
S22
R12
SLD
2
19
L-
S22
R12
L-
L+
3
S22
9
R12
L+
R-
4
S22
18
R12
R-
5
8
R+ S22
R12
R+
E120032E04
NS
NS–199
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY - STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the radio and navigation
assembly and stereo component amplifier.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
SLD
L+
R+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
L+ - L+
Always
Below 1 Ω
L- RR12
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
Always
Below 1 Ω
Always
Below 1 Ω
R- - R-
Always
Below 1 Ω
SLD - SLD
Always
Below 1 Ω
SLD - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
L+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
L- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
S22
L- - LR+ - R+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R+
RL+
L-
E121192E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–200
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly and
Stereo Jack Adapter
DESCRIPTION
The stereo jack adapter sends an external device sound signal to the radio and navigation assembly
through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier and then is sent to the
speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier radio and navigation assembly or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Jack Adapter
Radio and Navigation Assembly
4
AUXO S31
6
R27 ADPG
3
ASGN S31
5
R27 VA-
2
ARO S31
2
R27 VAR+
3
1
ALO S31
R27 VAL+
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
E121224E03
NS
NS–201
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY - STEREO
JACK ADAPTER)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the stereo jack adapter
and radio and navigation assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R27
VAR+
VAL+
Stereo Jack Adapter
Connector Front View:
ADPG
VA-
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AUXO - ADPG
Always
Below 1 Ω
ASGN - VA-
Always
Below 1 Ω
ARO - VAR+
Always
Below 1 Ω
ALO - VAL+
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXO - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ASGN - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ARO - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ALO - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
S31
ALO
ARO
ASGN
AUXO
E124115E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–202
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly and
Television Display Assembly
DESCRIPTION
The radio and navigation assembly controls the volume according to the MUTE signal from the television
display assembly.
The MUTE signal is sent to reduce noise and a popping sound generated when switching the mode, etc.
If there is an open in the circuit, noise can be heard from the speakers when changing the sound source.
If there is a short in the circuit, even though the radio and navigation assembly is normal, no sound or only
an extremely small sound can be produced.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display Assembly
Radio and Navigation Assembly
6
26
R11 MUTE
LMUT R18
E110892E18
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
R18
LMUT
E120036E08
NS
NG
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
LMUT - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC, RSE system is
playing → Changing
mode
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–203
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R11 and television display assembly connector R18.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
MUTE
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
MUTE - LMUT
Always
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
R11
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R18
LMUT
E121191E04
OK
3
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the television display assembly and check if it
operates normally.
OK:
The navigation system operates normally.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–204
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Mute Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly and
Stereo Component Amplifier
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the stereo component amplifier to mute noise. Because of that, the noise
produced by changing the sound source ceases.
If there is an open in the circuit, noise can be heard from the speakers when changing the sound source.
If there is a short in the circuit, even though the stereo component amplifier is normal, no sound, or only
an extremely small sound, can be produced.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
Radio and Navigation Assembly
7
1
R12 MUTE
MUTE S22
E110892E19
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
S22
MUTE
NS
Condition
Specified condition
MUTE - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC, Audio system is
playing → Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
OK
E120037E03
NG
Tester connection
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–205
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY - STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R12 and television display assembly connector S22.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
MUTE
R12
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
MUTE - MUTE
Always
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
MUTE
E121192E04
OK
3
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Replace the stereo component amplifier and check if it
operates normally.
OK:
The navigation system operates normally.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–49
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
R12
RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
R10
R26
R9
R11
R27
E120079E02
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
Parking brake signal
See "Vehicle Signal
Check" (See page NS-22)
-
PKB (R9-1) - GND (R12-20)
LG - BR
SPD (R9-3) - GND (R12-20)
R - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
See "Vehicle Signal
Check" (See page NS-22)
-
REV (R9-5) - GND (R12-20)
Y - BR
Reverse signal
See "Vehicle Signal
Check" (See page NS-22)
-
SWG (R10-6) - Body ground
W-R - Body ground
Steering pad switch signal
Always
Steering pad switch signal
No switch is pushed
→ SEEK+ switch pushed
→ SEEK- switch pushed
→ VOL+ switch pushed
→ VOL- switch pushed
4 V or more
→ Approx. 0.5 V
→ Approx. 0.9 V
→ Approx. 2.0 V
→ Approx. 3.4 V
Steering pad switch signal
No switch is pushed
→ MODE switch pushed
→ ON HOOK switch
pushed
→ OFF HOOK switch
pushed
→ VOICE switch pushed
4 V or more
→ Approx. 0.5 V
→ Approx. 0.9 V
→ Approx. 2.0 V
→ Approx. 3.4 V
SW1 (R10-7) - SWG (R10-6)
SW2 (R10-8) - SWG (R10-6)
V-W - W-R
Y-B - W-R
Below 1 V
IVO+ (R10-11) - GND (R12-20)
L - BR
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
IVO- (R10-12) - GND (R12-20)
P - BR
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
SLD1 (R10-13) - Body ground
Shielded - Body
ground
Voice sound signal
shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
CSLD (R11-1) - Body ground (*1)
Shielded - Body
ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
CDR+ (R11-2) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
B - BR
RSE system sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
CDR- (R11-3) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
W - BR
RSE system sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
CDL+ (R11-4) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
R - BR
RSE system sound signal
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
NS
NS–50
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
CDL- (R11-5) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
G - BR
RSE system sound signal
RSE system is playing
MUTE (R11-6) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
V - BR
Mute signal
RSE system is playing→
Source is changed with
remote controller (signal
from RSE system)
TXM+ (R11-9) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
R - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
TXM- (R11-10) - GND (R12-20)
(*1)
G -BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
B (R12-1) - GND (R12-20)
L-Y - BR
Condition
Battery
Always
ILL+ (R12-2) - GND (R12-20)
G - BR
Illumination signal
Turn ignition switch ON
Light control switch OFF
→ TAIL or ON
ATX+ (R12-5) - GND (R12-20)
B - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
MUTE (R12-7) - GND (R12-20)
W-R - BR
Mute signal
Audio system is playing→
Changing
Specification
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
10 to 14 V
Below 1V → 10 to 14 V
2 to 3 V
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
R+ (R12-8) - GND (R12-20)
B - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
L+ (R12-9) - GND (R12-20)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
SLD (R12-10) - Body ground
Shielded - Body
ground
Shielded ground
Always
ACC (R12-11) - GND (R12-20)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch OFF→
ACC or ON
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
ILL- (R12-12) - GND (R12-20)
W-G - BR
Illumination signal
Turn ignition switch ON
Light control switch OFF
→ TAIL or ON
Below 1 V →10 to 14 V
ANT (R12-13) - GND (R12-20)
B - BR
Power source of antenna
Radio switch ON and AM
or FM
10 to 14 V
ATX- (R12-15) - GND (R12-20)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
R- (R12-18) - GND (R12-20)
W - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
L- (R12-19) - GND (R12-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
GND (R12-20) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
L - BR
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone Check"
(See page NS-27)
-
P - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone Check"
(See page NS-27)
-
MACC (R26-17) - GND (R12-20)
W - BR
Microphone AMP power
supply
Turn ignition switch OFF
→ ON
Below 1 V → 5 V
TSW- (R26-12) - GND (R12 -20)
B - BR
Telephone relation switch
signal
Always
Below 1 V
SGND- (R26-18) - GND (R12-20)
B - BR
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
CA+ (R26-24) - GND (R12-20)
R - BR
Television camera power
supply
Turn ignition switch ON,
shift lever in R position
CGND (R26-21) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Ground
Always
V+ (R26-22) - CGND (R12-21)
B-W
Television camera image
signal
Turn ignition switch ON,
shift lever in R position
V- (R26-23) - CGND (R12-21)
Shielded - W
Shielded ground
Always
MIC+ (R26-19) - GND (R12-20)
MIC- (R26-20) - Body ground
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Below 1 V
2 to 3 V
Below 1 V
Approx. 6 V
Below 1 V
Pulse generation
(Refer to waveform 2)
Below 1 V
NS–51
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
VV+ (R27-1) - GND (R12-20) (*1)
VV- (R27-4) - Body ground (*1)
P - BR
L - Body ground
Terminal Description
Condition
Display signal
DVD is played on radio
and navigation assembly
Ground
Always
Specification
A waveform
synchronized with
display signals is
output. (Refer to
waveform 1)
Below 1 V
VAR+ (R27-2) - GND (R12-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Right)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
VAL+ (R27-3) - GND (R12-20)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform
synchronized with
sound is output
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
External device
connection detection
signal
External device is
connection
Below 1 V
VA- (R27-5) - Body ground
Shielded - Body
ground
ADPG (R27 - 6) - GND (R12-20)
L - BR
*1: with Rear Seat Entertainment System
(a) Reference: waveform 1
HINT:
• Terminal: VV+ - VV• Gauge set: 200 mV/DIV, 10 µs/DIV
• Condition: DVD is played on radio and navigation
assembly
GND
E120080E01
GND
2.
(b) Reference: waveform 2
HINT:
• Terminal: V+ - CGND
• Gauge set: 0.2 V/DIV, 0.2µs/DIV
• Condition: Ignition switch: ON, shift lever: R
position
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
E057967E08
S23
S22
E120081E04
Symbols (Terminal No.)
MUTE (S22-1) - GND2 (S23-15)
Wiring Color
W-R - BR
Terminal Description
Mute signal from radio
receiver
Condition
Specified Condition
Audio system is playing →
Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
NS
NS–52
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
L- (S22-2) - GND2 (S23-15)
G - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
L+ (S22-3) - GND2 (S23-15)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
R- (S22-4) - GND2 (S23-15)
W - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
R+ (S22-5) - GND2 (S23-15)
B - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
Shielded ground
Always
SLD (S22-6) - Body ground
Shielded - Body
ground
Below 1 V
TX- (S22-7) - GND2 (S23-15)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
TX+ (S22-8) - GND2 (S23-15)
B - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
2 to 3 V
SPD (S22-11) - GND2 (S23-15)
V-R - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
Turn ignition switch to ON.
Drive wheels are turned
slowly
ACC (S22-12) - GND2 (S23-15)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch OFF
→ ACC
INT- (S22-22) - GND2 (S23-15)
P - BR
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
INT+ (S22-23) - GND2 (S23-15)
L - BR
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
Battery
Always
+B (S23-1) - GND2 (S23-15)
W-L - BR
Pulse generation
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
10 to 14 V
CTR+ (S23-3) - GND2 (S23-15)
G - BR
Sound signal (Front
Center)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
RL+ (S23-4) - GND2 (S23-15)
B - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
RR+ (S23-5) - GND2 (S23-15)
R - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
FL+ (S23-6) - GND2 (S23-15)
P - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
FR+ (S23-7) - GND2 (S23-15)
LG - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
WFL+ (S23-8) - GND2 (S23-15)
BR - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
WFR+ (S23-9) - GND2 (S23-15)
L-B - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
+B2 (S23-10) - GND2 (S23-15)
W-L - BR
Battery
Always
CTR- (S23-12) - GND2 (S23-15)
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
RL- (S23-13) - GND2 (S23-15)
G-B - BR
Y - BR
10 to 14 V
Sound signal (Front
Center)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
NS–53
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
RR- (S23-14) - GND2 (S23-15)
W - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is playing
GND2 (S23-15) - Body ground
BR - Body Ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
GND (S23-16) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
FL- (S23-17) - GND2 (S23-15)
V - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
FR- (S23-18) - GND2 (S23-15)
L- BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
WFL- (S23-19) - GND2 (S23-15)
G-W- BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
WFR- (S23-20) - GND2 (S23-15)
L-R - BR
Sound signal (Woofer
Box)
Audio system is playing
A waveform
synchronized with
sounds is output
3.
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page AV-155)
NS
NS–206
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to the AVC-LAN (communication bus) transfers the signal of
each switch by communication.
When a short to +B or short to ground occurs in this AVC-LAN, the navigation system will not function
normally as the communication is discontinued.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R12-5) ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
all AVC-LAN circuits.
(1) Check for an open or short in all AVC-LAN circuits.
NS
NS–207
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–208
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Stereo Component Amplifier and
Combination Meter
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is necessary for the ASL (Auto Sound Leveliser) built into the stereo component amplifier.
Speed signals are received from the combination meter and used for the ASL.
The ASL function automatically adjusts the sound data in order to enable hearing the clear audio sound
even when vehicle noise increases (as vehicle noise increases, the volume is turned up etc.).
HINT:
• A voltage of 12 V or 5 V is output from each ECU and then input to the combination meter. The signal
is changed to a pulse signal at the transistor in the combination meter. Each ECU controls the
respective system based on the pulse signal.
• If a short occurs in an ECU, all systems in the diagram below will not operate normally.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
11
S22 SPD
From A/C Control
Assembly
From Moon Roof
Control ECU
From ECM
From 4WD Control ECU
From Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
5
C9
From Main Body ECU
Combination Meter
From Speed Sensor
E120038E04
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–209
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer on the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
CHECK COMBINATION METER
OK
2
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connector
S22.
(b) Measure the voltage.
(1) Jack up either one of the drive wheels.
(2) Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
SPD
E120039E02
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the
stereo component amplifier and body ground when
the drive wheels are turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage pulses as shown in the illustration.
NG
4.5 to 14 V
Go to step 3
Below 2 V
0
Turn the wheel
E110855E01
NS
NS–210
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (BUILT- IN STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connector
S22 and combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD - C9-5
Ignition switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
NG
SPD
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
C9-5
E120040E01
OK
NS
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
NS–211
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connector
S22 and combination meter connector C9.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
SPD
Combination Meter (Left Side of Vehicle)
Connector Front View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD - Body ground
Ignition switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the resistance between terminal SPD and body ground
is less than 10 kΩ, there may be a short in a wire
harness, connector, or an ECU that is connected to the
SPD signal wire.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR OR CHECK EACH ECU
C9-5
E120040E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
NS
NS–212
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Reverse Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The radio and navigation assembly receives a reverse signal from the park/neutral position switch and
information about the GPS antenna, and then adjusts vehicle position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio and Navigation
Assembly
P1
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
5
From
IG1
Fuse
2
R9
1
REV
E120120E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
REV
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
REV - Body ground
Ignition switch is ON.
Shift lever is moved to
R position.
10 to 14 V
REV - Body ground
Ignition switch is ON.
Shift lever is moved to
any position except R.
Below 1 V
R9
OK
E113510E04
NG
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NS–213
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION - PARK / NEUTRAL
POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9 and park/neutral position switch connector P1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
REV
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
REV - P1-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
REV - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
R9
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Connector Front View:
P1
E120121E02
OK
3
INSPECT PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
Park/Neutral Position Switch:
P1
(a) Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector
P1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P1-1 - P1-2
Shift lever is moved to
R
Below 1 Ω
P1-1 - P1-2
Shift lever is moved to
any position except R.
10 kΩ or higher
E120122E01
NG
REPLACE PARK / NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
NS
NS–214
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
NS
NS–215
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Navigation Voice Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is used when the voice guidance in the navigation system is on.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
Radio and Navigation Assembly
22
S22
INT-
12
R10 IVO-
23
INT+ S22
11
R10 IVO+
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
13
R10 SLD1
E121187E01
NS
NS–216
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY - STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R10 and stereo component amplifier connector S22.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
IVO-
IVO+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IVO+ - INT+
Always
Below 1 Ω
IVO- - INT-
Always
Below 1 Ω
IVO+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
IVO- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R10
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Stereo Component Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
S22
INT+
INT-
E121188E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–217
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Display Signal Circuit between Television Display Assembly and Radio
and Navigation Assembly
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a DVD image signal from the television display assembly to the radio and navigation
assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display Assembly
NTS1
Radio and Navigation Assembly
11
R18
1
R27 VV+
4
R27 VV-
10
SG3 R18
9
SGN1 R18
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
E121197E03
NS
NS–218
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY)
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R27
VV+
VVTelevision Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R27 and television display assembly connector R18.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
VV+ - NTS1
Always
Below 1 Ω
VV- - SG3
Always
Below 1 Ω
VV+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
VV- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R18
SG3
NTS1
E121198E02
OK
2
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the television display assembly connector
R18.
(b) Measure the waveform according to the table below.
OK
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
DVD display is ON
A waveform
synchronized with
display signals is
output
R27
VV+ - Body ground
NS
HINT:
The waveform pattern may differ from that shown in the
illustration below due to differences in oscilloscope
setting. A normal television display assembly operating
condition can be determined if any waveform is output.
VV+
E113508E02
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–219
(c) Oscilloscope waveform
(1) Terminal: VV+ - Body ground
Setting: 200 mV/DIV., 10 µs/DIV.
Condition: DVD display is ON.
NG
GND
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
E111833E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–220
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Microphone Circuit between Microphone and Radio and Navigation
Assembly
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a microphone signal from the microphone to the radio and navigation assembly.
It also supplies power from the radio and navigation assembly to the microphone.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Microphone
Radio and Navigation Assembly
5
ACC T18
17
R26 MACC
1
MIC- T18
20
R26 MIC-
3
MIC+ T18
19
R26 MIC+
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
12
R26 TSW18
R26 SGND
E121194E02
NS
NS–221
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
MACC - Body ground
Ignition SW ACC
4 to 6 V
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
R26
MACC
E121195E02
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R26.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
Condition
Specified condition
SGND - TSW-
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
R26
SGND
Tester connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
TSWE113512E02
OK
NS
NS–222
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MICROPHONE - RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the microphone connector T18 and radio and
navigation assembly connector R26.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Microphone Wire Harness View:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ACC - MACC
Always
Below 1 Ω
MIC+ - MIC+
Always
Below 1 Ω
MIC- - MIC-
Always
Below 1 Ω
MACC - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MIC+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MIC- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
T18
ACC
MIC-
MIC+
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
R26
MACC
MIC-
MIC+
E121196E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–223
Stereo Component Amplifier Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page NS30).
Example:
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E121199E05
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio and navigation assembly (140)
Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit (See page NS-229)
Television display assembly (1B0)
Television display assembly power source circuit (See page NS-231)
NS
NS–224
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NEXT
3
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R12-5) ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the stereo component
amplifier and the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the stereo
component amplifier and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the stereo component amplifier and the
component shown by the sub-code.
NS
NS–225
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE WOOFER BOX SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY (BUILT-IN STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
OK
END
NS
NS–226
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Radio and Navigation Assembly Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page NS30).
Example:
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E121199E05
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
NS
Component
Proceed to
Television display assembly (1B0)
Television display assembly power source circuit (See page NS-231)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (See page NS-227)
NS–227
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NEXT
3
CHECK RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ATX+ (R12-5) ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio and
navigation assembly and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio and navigation assembly and the
component shown by the sub-code.
NS
NS–228
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–229
Television Display Assembly Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY THE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (See page NS30).
Example:
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E121199E05
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component Table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio and navigation assembly (140)
Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit (See page NS-229)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (See page NS-227)
NS
NS–230
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
R12
R11
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ATX+ (R12-5) - ATX- (R12-15)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXM+ (R11-9) - TXM- (R11-10)
Always
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TXM+
ATX+ ATX-
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
TXME120086E02
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (See page NS-45).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the television display
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the television
display assembly and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the television display assembly and the
component shown by the sub-code.
NS
NS–231
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN WARNING DIAGRAM:
Stereo Component Amplifier (*2)
8
TX+ S22
7
TX-
S22
Radio and Navigation Assembly (*1)
5
9
R12 ATX+
TXM+ R11
14
R18 TX+
10
R11
13
R18 TX-
15
R12 ATX-
Television Display Assembly (*2)
TXM-
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
E120087E02
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
OK
END
NS
NS–232
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Stereo Component Amplifier Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the stereo component amplifier.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
RADIO No. 2
From Battery
1
S23 +B
10
S23 +B2
ACC CUT Relay
From ACC Fuse
12
S22 ACC
15
S23 GND2
16
S23 GND
E120047E02
NS
NS–233
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Disconnect the stereo component amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
S23
S22
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
+B
GND
GND2
+B2
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B2 - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
+B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
ACC
E120048E05
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–54
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
HINT:
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
• If the system cannot enter the diagnostic mode, inspect all
AVC-LAN communication components and repair or
replace problem parts (See page NS-201).
• After the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the map
is displayed before starting the diagnostic mode.
Otherwise, some items cannot be checked.
1. START DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) There are 2 methods to start diagnostic mode. Start
the mode by using one of them.
(b) Method 1
(1) Start the engine.
(2) While pressing and holding the "INFO" switch,
operate the light control switch: OFF → Turn ON
→ Turn OFF → Turn ON → Turn OFF → Turn
ON → Turn OFF.
(3) The diagnostic mode starts and the "System
Check Mode" screen will be displayed. Service
inspection starts automatically and the result will
be displayed.
“INFO” Switch
E120082E01
(c)
2.
E109432
NS
Method 2
(1) Start the engine.
(2) Switch to the "Display Check" screen.
(3) From the display quality adjustment screen,
touch the corners of the screen in the following
order: upper left → lower left → upper left →
lower left → upper left → lower left.
(4) The diagnostic mode starts and the "System
Check Mode" screen will be displayed. Service
inspection starts automatically and the result will
be displayed.
FINISH DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) There are 2 methods to end diagnostic mode. Use
one of them.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Press and hold the "DISPLAY" switch for 3
seconds.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3.
NS–55
DIAGNOSIS MENU
(a) The "Diagnosis MENU" screen will be displayed by
pressing the menu switch on the "System Check
Mode" screen.
E120083E01
NS
NS–56
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4.
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
E111721E02
NS
CHECK DTC
(a) Read the system check result.
(1) If the check result is "EXCH", "CHEK" or "Old",
touch the displayed check result to view the
results on the "Unit Check Mode" screen and
record them.
HINT:
• If all check results are "OK", go to
communication DTC check.
• If a device name is not known, its physical
address is displayed.
• When proceeding to view the results of
another device, press the service switch to
return to the "System Check Mode" screen.
Repeat this step.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–57
(b) Read the communication diagnostic check result.
(1) Return to the "System Check Mode" screen, and
press the "LAN Mon" switch to enter the "LAN
Monitor" screen.
I038208E05
NS
NS–58
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(2) If the check result is "CHEK" or "Old", touch the
displayed check result to view the results on the
individual communication diagnostic screen and
record them.
HINT:
• If all check results are "No Err", the system
judges that no DTC exists.
• The sub-code (relevant device) will be
indicated by its physical address.
• When proceeding to view the results of
another device, press the "Service" switch to
return to the original "LAN Monitor" screen.
Repeat this step.
Sub-code
Logical Address
Diagnosis Code
E120084E01
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
5.
NS–59
DTC CLEAR/RECHECK
(a) Clear DTC
(1) Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3 seconds.
(2) The check results are cleared.
I038211E02
(b) Recheck
(1) Press the "Recheck" switch.
I038212E01
(2) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are "OK" when
the check results are displayed. If a code other
than "OK" is displayed, troubleshoot again.
I038213E01
(3) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to the
"LAN Monitor" screen.
I038213E02
(4) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are "No Err". If
a code other than "No Err" is displayed,
troubleshoot again.
NS
I038214E01
NS–234
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Radio and Navigation Assembly Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source circuit to operate the radio and navigation assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio and Navigation Assembly
RADIO No. 1
Short Pin
ACC CUT Relay
From ACC Fuse
1
R12 B
11
R12 ACC
20
R12 GND
E121223E05
NS
NS–235
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R12.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness View:
B
ACC
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
GND
R12
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
E113513E04
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–236
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Television Display Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source circuit to operate the television display assembly.
NS
NS–237
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Display Assembly
Short Pin
RADIO No. 1
I18
Ignition SW
ACC
AM1
ALT
ACC CUT Relay
16
R18 +B2
15
R18 ACC4
12
R18 GND6
Battery
E119746E01
NS
NS–238
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector from the television display
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Television Display Assembly
Wire Harness View:
R18
+B2
ACC4
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND6 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B2 - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC4 - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
GND6
E113507E04
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–236
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION RECEIVER
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL RADIO NO. 2 BRACKET
2.
INSTALL RADIO NO. 1 BRACKET
3.
INSTALL RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY (w/
Bracket)
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
5.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
7.
INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
8.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER
10. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ANTENNA
NS–239
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly (See page IP-6).
2.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ANTENNA
(a) Remove the 3 clamps.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and navigation antenna.
I033320
NS
NS–240
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ANTENNA
INSTALLATION
NS
1.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ANTENNA
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures of the instrument
panel safety pad sub-assembly (See page IP-12).
NS–60
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
COMMUNICATION DIAGNOSIS:
DTC No.
01-21
NS
Detection Item
ROM Error
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
See page
NS-59
01-22
RAM Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-59
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
1. Power source circuit of the component shown by the
sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the sub-code
NS-60
01-D6
No Master
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
2. Power source circuit of the component which has
stored this code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
4. Component which has stored this code
5. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-62
01-D7
Connection Check Error
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
2. Power source circuit of the component which has
stored this code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
4. Component which has stored this code
5. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-62
01-D8
No Response for Connection Check
1. Power source circuit of the component shown by the
sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the sub-code
NS-60
01-D9
Last Mode Error
1. Power source circuit of the component shown by the
sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the sub-code
NS-60
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF Command
1. Power source circuit of the component shown by the
sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the sub-code
NS-60
01-DB
Mode Status Error
1. Power source circuit of the component shown by the
sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the sub-code
NS-60
01-DC
Transmission Error
If the same sub-code is recorded in other components,
check harness for power supply and communication
system of all components shown by code
NS-66
01-DD
Master Reset
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
3. Radio and navigation assembly
4. Component which has stored this code
NS-69
01-DE
Slave Reset
1. Power source circuit of the component shown by the
sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the sub-code
3. Component shown by the sub-code
NS-60
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
NS–61
Trouble Area
See page
01-DF
Master Error
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
3. Radio and navigation assembly
4. Component which has stored this code
NS-73
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication Error
-
NS-77
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON Error
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component which has stored this
code
3. Radio and navigation assembly
4. Component which has stored this code
NS-69
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-78
01-E3
Registration Demand Transmission
-
NS-77
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
-
NS-77
SW:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
21-10
Panel Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
21-11
Touch Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
SW WITH NAME:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
23-10
Panel Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
23-11
Touch Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
SW CONVERTING:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
24-10
Panel Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
24-11
Touch Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
COMMAND SW:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
25-10
Panel Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
25-11
Touch Switch Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-79
FRONT MONITOR:
DTC No.
34-10
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
Error in Picture Circuit
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-80
34-11
No Current in Back-light Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-80
34-12
Excess Current in Back-light Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-80
DVD PLAYER:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
44-10
DVD Player Mechanical Error
Television display assembly
NS-81
44-11
DVD Insertion and Eject Error
Television display assembly
NS-81
44-12
DVD Reading Abnormal
Television display assembly
NS-81
44-41
Wrong Disc
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
NS-82
44-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
NS-82
44-43
DVD-ROM Abnormal
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
NS-84
44-44
DVD Error
Television display assembly
NS-85
44-45
Eject Error
Television display assembly
NS-86
NS
NS–62
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
44-46
Detection Item
Scratched / Reversed Disc
Trouble Area
See page
Television display assembly
NS-87
44-47
High Temperature
Television display assembly
NS-89
44-48
Excess Current
Television display assembly
NS-85
44-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Television display assembly
NS-85
44-51
Elevator Error
Television display assembly
NS-86
44-52
Clamp Error
Television display assembly
NS-86
44-78
DSP Error
-
NS-90
44-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
NS-91
44-7E
No Playable Files
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
NS-91
44-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. DVD
2. Television display assembly
NS-91
TELEPHONE:
DTC No.
57-47
Detection Item
Bluetooth Module Initialization Failed
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
See page
NS-92
NAVI:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
58-10
Gyro Error
1. Gyro sensor
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-93
58-11
GPS Receiver Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-95
58-40
GPS Antenna Error
1. Wier harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-96
58-41
GPS Antenna Power Source Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-96
58-42
Map Disc Read Error
1. Map Disc
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-97
58-43
SPD Signal Error
1. Speed signal circuit
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-99
58-44
Player Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-100
58-45
High Temperature
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-101
IN-DASH CD CHANGER:
DTC No.
NS
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
63-10
CD Changer Mechanical Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-106
63-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-106
63-12
CD Reading Abnormal
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-106
63-41
Wrong Disc
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-107
63-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-107
63-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-109
63-44
CD Abnormal
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-110
63-45
Eject Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-111
63-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-112
63-47
High Temperature
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-114
63-48
Excess Current
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-110
63-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-110
63-51
Elevator Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-111
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
63-52
Detection Item
Clamp Error
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
NS–63
See page
NS-111
63-78
DSP Error
-
NS-115
63-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-116
63-7E
No Playable Files
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-116
63-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. CD
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-116
GPS:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
80-10
Gyro Error
1. Gyro sensor
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-93
80-11
GPS Receiver Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-95
80-40
GPS Antenna Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-96
80-41
GPS Antenna Power Source Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-96
80-42
Map Disc Read Error
1. Map disc
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-97
80-43
SPD Signal Error
1. Speed signal circuit
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-99
80-44
Player Error
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-100
80-45
High Temperature
Radio and navigation assembly
NS-101
CAMERA UNIT:
DTC No.
5C-40
Detection Item
Camera Picture Error
Trouble Area
1. Wire harness
2. Television camera assembly
3. Radio and navigation assembly
See page
NS-102
NS
NS–64
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-21
ROM Error
DTC
01-22
RAM Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-21
A malfunction exists in ROM.
01-22
A malfunction exists in RAM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
NS
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
Trouble Area
Radio and navigation assembly
NS–65
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
DTC
01-D8
No Response for Connection Check
DTC
01-D9
Last Mode Error
DTC
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF Command
DTC
01-DB
Mode Status Error
DTC
01-DE
Slave Reset
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
•
Trouble Area
A component shown by the sub-code is (was)
disconnected from the system when turning the
ignition switch to the ON or ACC position.
The communication condition with the device that
the code shows cannot be obtained when the
engine starts.
01-D5
*1, *4
•
01-D8
*2, *4
A component shown by the sub-code is (was)
disconnected from the system after engine start.
01-D9
*1, *4
The device that had functioned before the engine
stopped is (was) disconnected from the system when
the ignition switch to the ON or ACC position.
•
•
•
•
01-DA
*4
No response is identified when changing mode.
Detected when sound and image do not change by
switch operation.
01-DB
*1, *4
A dual alarm is detected.
01-DE
*3, *4
A slave device has been disconnected after engine
start.
•
Power source circuit of the component shown by
the sub-code
AVC-LAN circuit between the radio and navigation
assembly and the component shown by the subcode
Component shown by the sub-code
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
engine start voltage.
• *2: If the power connector is disconnected after the engine starts, this code is stored after 180 seconds.
• *3: This code may be stored if the engine is started and then the ignition switch is turned to the START
position again.
• *4: If it is reported that the device does not exist during verification, check the power source circuit and
AVC-LAN circuit for the device.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The radio and navigation assembly is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
NS
NS–66
1
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK "RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY COMMUNICATION ERROR" IN FLOW
CHART
Refer to the radio and navigation assembly communication
error (See page NS-221).
NEXT
END
NS
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–3
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
Item
GENERAL
(a) To assist the driver with parking the vehicle by
displaying an image of the area behind the vehicle,
this system has a television camera mounted on the
luggage compartment door. The system displays
the image on the radio and navigation assembly.
(b) This system consists of the following components:
(1) Radio and navigation assembly
(2) Television camera assembly
(c) This system is equipped with a self-diagnosis
system, which is operated on a dedicated window
that appears on the display panel, just as in the
navigation system.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
(a) The radio and navigation assembly controls the
system by using information from the following
components:
Function
•
Television Camera Assembly
•
•
•
Radio and Navigation Assembly
•
Mounted on the luggage compartment door to transmit the rear
view of the vehicle to the radio and navigation assembly.
A color video camera that uses a CCD (Charge Coupled Device)
and a wide-angle lens.
Transmits video signals, which contain an image of the area
behind the vehicle taken with the television camera assembly.
Radio and navigation assembly effects control of the system by
receiving the shift position signal from park/neutral position switch.
Displays the rear view monitor image on the display panel.
Transmits a reverse shift position signal to the radio and navigation
assembly.
Park/Neutral Position Switch
3.
4.
OPERATION EXPLANATION
(a) The radio and navigation assembly receives the R
position signal from the park / neutral position switch
when the shift lever is moved to the R position. After
receiving the R position signal, the radio and
navigation assembly switches from the navigation
system to the rear view monitor system.
NOTES FOR REAR VIEW MONITOR
(a) Notes for the rear view monitor.
(1) The rear view monitor may not function properly
if subjected to a severe blow by any hard object.
(2) Do not "scrub" the cover part of the camera
(resin made). Scrubbing it may scratch the cover
and affect the image. Prevent organic solvents,
waxes, bond removing solvents, or glass coating
from adhering to the cover. Clean it off
immediately, and wash with water.
(3) Exposing the camera to a sudden temperature
change may affect proper functioning of the
camera.
(4) A clear image may not appear if the camera is
dirty with snow, mud, etc. In that case, wash it
with water and wipe off the lens. Use a detergent
to remove dirt if necessary.
PM
PM–4
PM
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
(b) Images are difficult to discern even in normal
conditions if:
(1) Camera screen is frosted over (the image
immediately after turning the ignition switch to
the on position may be blurred or darker than
normal).
(2) A strong beam of light, such as a sunbeam or
headlight, hits the camera.
(3) It is too dark around the camera (at night, etc.).
(4) The ambient temperature around the camera is
either too high or too low.
HINT:
When a strong light, such as a sunbeam
reflected off the vehicle's body, hits the camera,
the image may be blurred. This is called the
"SMEAR" phenomenon, peculiar to the CCD
camera.
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–5
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
PM
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
CHECK AND CLEAR DTCs
(a) Refer to the diagnostic check/clear (See page NS-49).
NEXT
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
SYMPTOM DOES NOT OCCUR (Go to step 5)
SYMPTOM OCCURS (Go to step 6)
5
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
6
CHECK DTC
DTC IS OUTPUT (Go to step 10)
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT (Go to step 7)
7
CHECK IF THE SAME SYMPTOM APPEARS IN THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(a) Refer to the navigation system (See page NS-41).
THE SYMPTOM APPEARS (FOLLOW THE
NAVIGATION SYMPTOM CHART TO
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING)
THE SYMPTOM DOES NOT APPEAR (Go to
step 8)
PM–6
8
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Refer to the problem symptoms table (See page PM-5).
THE CORRESPONDING SYMPTOM EXISTS
(Go to step 10)
PM
THE CORRESPONDING SYMPTOM DOES
NOT EXIST (Go to step 9)
9
BASED ON THE MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM, PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING BELOW
(a) Terminals of ECU (See page PM-6).
NEXT
10
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
11
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
PM–7
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
• Before inspecting the suspected areas listed in the table
below, check the fuse and relay.
• Before inspecting the suspected areas listed in the table
below, check the DTCs.
• Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed
in order of probability in the suspected area column.
REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Symptom
When shift lever is in R position, rear view monitor
image is not displayed (Screen is not black).
When shift lever is in R position, rear view monitor
image is not displayed (Screen is black).
When shift lever is not in R position, rear view monitor
image is displayed.
Problem with the rear view monitor image (color,
disorder of picture).
Suspected area
See page
1. Reverse signal circuit
PM-7
2. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Camera Assembly"
PM-10
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Radio and navigation assembly power source circuit
NS-229
2. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Camera Assembly"
PM-10
3. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Reverse signal circuit
PM-7
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
1. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Radio and
Navigation Assembly and Television Camera Assembly"
PM-10
2. Radio and navigation assembly
NS-235
PM
PM–8
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the T11 camera connector.
T11
PM
E130378E01
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of each
terminal of the wire harness side connector.
Wiring Color
Terminal
Description
CGND (T11-2) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Ground
CB+ (T11-1) - CGND (T11-2)
R-W
Power source
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified value
Below 1 Ω
Always
Ignition switch ON, shift lever R
position
Approx. 6 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the T11 camera connector.
(d) Measure the voltage and frequency of each terminal
of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CV+ (T11-4) - CV- (T11-3)
Wiring Color
Terminal
Description
B - Shielded
Display signal
Condition
Specified value
Ignition switch ON, shift lever R
position
See waveform 1
If the result is not as specified, the camera may
have a malfunction.
(e) Reference:
Oscilloscope waveform
(1) Waveform 1
Item
GND
2.
E119731E01
Content
Measure terminal
CV+ - CV-
Measure set
0.2 V/DIV., 0.2 µS/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch: ON, Shift lever: R position
RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY (See page NS45)
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–1
REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
BODY ASSIST
PARK
ELECTRICAL
/ MONITORING
PARTS LOCATION
PM
ENGINE ROOM R/B:
DRIVER SIDE J/B:
ACC FUSE
RADIO NO. 1
FUSE
RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
BACK MONITOR CAMERA WIRE
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
E116255E01
PM–2
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
From Battery
PM
Reverse Signal
Radio and Navigation
Assembly
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Television Camera
Assembly
Visual Signal
E121276E01
PM–9
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Reverse Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The radio and navigation assembly receives a reverse signal from the park/neutral position switch.
PM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio and Navigation
Assembly
P1
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
5
From
GAUGE1
Fuse
2
R9
1
REV
E120120E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness View:
REV
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
REV - Body ground
Ignition switch is ON.
Shift lever is moved to
R position.
10 to 14 V
REV - Body ground
Ignition switch is ON.
Shift lever is moved to
any position except R.
Below 1 V
R9
OK
E113510E10
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PM–10
2
PM
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY - PARK/
NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the radio and navigation assembly connector
R9 and park/neutral position switch connector P1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Radio and Navigation Assembly
Wire Harness View:
REV
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
REV - P1-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
REV - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
OK
R9
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Connector Front View:
P1
E132185E01
OK
3
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Park/Neutral Position Switch:
P1
(a) Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector
P1.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P1-1 - P1-2
Shift lever is moved to
R position.
Below 1 Ω
P1-1 - P1-2
Shift lever is moved to
any position except R.
10 kΩ or higher
E120122E01
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–11
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
PM
PM–14
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – TELEVISION CAMERA
TELEVISION CAMERA
BODY ASSIST
PARK
ELECTRICAL
/ MONITORING
COMPONENTS
BACK DOOR SERVICE
HOLE COVER LH
PM
BACK DOOR
TRIM BOARD
Non-reusable part
B134215E02
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – TELEVISION CAMERA
PM–15
PM
TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
E115641E01
PM–12
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Display Signal Circuit between Radio and Navigation Assembly and
Television Camera Assembly
DESCRIPTION
PM
This is the display signal circuit of the television camera assembly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
T11
Television Camera Assembly
Radio and Navigation Assembly
22
R26 V+
CV+ 4
CGND
21
R26 CGND
2
24
R26 CA+
CB+ 1
CV-
3
(*1)
(*1)
(*1)
(*1)
23
R26 V-
*1: Shielded
E120090E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the R26 connector from the radio and
navigation assembly.
(b) Disconnect the T11 connector from the television camera
assembly.
PM–13
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Radio and Navigation Assembly:
Television Camera Assembly:
T11
CGND
R26
CV+
PM
CB+
CV-
CGND
CA+
V-
V+
E130380E01
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified condition
CB+ (T11-1) - CA+ (R26-24)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CGND (T11-2) - CGND (R26-21)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CV+ (T11-4) - V+ (R26-22)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CV- (T11-3) - V- (R26-23)
Always
Below 1 Ω
CB+ (T11-1) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
CGND (T11-2) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
CV+ (T11-4) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
CV- (T11-3) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
INSPECT RADIO AND NAVIGATION ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the radio and navigation assembly R26
connector.
PM–14
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Television Camera Assembly
Connector Front View:
Radio and Navigation Assembly:
PM
T11
CB+
CGND
R26
E130381E01
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
CB+ (T11-1) - CGND (T11-2)
Ignition switch ON
Shift lever R position
Approx. 6 V
NG
REPLACE RADIO AND NAVIGATION
ASSEMBLY
OK
3
INSPECT TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Reconnect the radio and navigation assembly R26
connector and the television camera assembly T11
connector.
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Radio and Navigation Assembly:
PM–15
Television Camera Assembly:
PM
T11
CV+
CV-
R26
E130382E02
(b) Check the waveform of the television camera assembly
using an oscilloscope.
(1) Measurement terminal: CV+ - CVMeasurement setting: 0.2 V/DIV, 0.2 µs/DIV
Condition: Ignition switch ON, Shift lever in R range
OK:
Pulses as shown in the illustration.
GND
NG
E119731E02
REPLACE TELEVISION CAMERA
ASSEMBLY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PM–16
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – TELEVISION CAMERA
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
3.
REMOVE TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector and remove the
connector clamp.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and the television camera
assembly.
PM
I033315
INSTALLATION
I033315
1.
INSTALL TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the television camera assembly and the 2
screws.
(b) Install the connector clamp and reconnect the
connector.
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
3.
INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD
HORN – HORN SYSTEM
HO–1
HORN SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
HORN
PARTS LOCATION
STEERING WHEEL PAD
(HORN BUTTON SWITCH)
HO
HIGH PITCHED HORN
LOW PITCHED HORN
HORN RELAY
INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
C131376E01
HO–2
HORN – HORN SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HORN SYSTEM
Symptom
horn does not sound.
HO
Suspected area
See page
1. Horn button switch
-
2. High pitched horn
HO-7
3. Low pitched horn
HO-5
4. HORN relay
HO-3
5. Wire harness
-
HO–3
HORN – HORN RELAY
HORN RELAY
INSPECTION
1.
B016200E24
INSPECT HORN RELAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the horn relay from the instrument panel
junction block assembly.
(b) Inspect the horn relay continuity.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
1-2
Always
3-5
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay
assembly.
HO
HO–4
HORN – LOW PITCHED HORN
LOW PITCHED HORN
BODY ELECTRICAL
HORN
COMPONENTS
HO
20 (199, 15)
LOW PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120216E02
HORN – LOW PITCHED HORN
HO–5
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE LOW PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and horn assembly.
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT LOW PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the
terminal and the negative (-) lead to the horn body,
and check that the horn blows.
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn
assembly.
B064930
INSTALLATION
1.
B062198
INSTALL LOW PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the stay onto the baffle part in the radiator
support upper, and then install the horn assembly
with the bolt.
Torque: 20 N*m (199 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
HO
HO–6
HORN – HIGH PITCHED HORN
HIGH PITCHED HORN
BODY ELECTRICAL
HORN
COMPONENTS
HO
20 (199, 15)
HIGH PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120216E03
HORN – HIGH PITCHED HORN
HO–7
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE HIGH PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and horn assembly.
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT HIGH PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the
terminal and the negative (-) lead to the horn body,
and check that the horn blows.
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn
assembly.
B064929
INSTALLATION
1.
B065154
INSTALL HIGH PITCHED HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the stay onto the baffle part in the radiator
support upper, and then install the horn assembly
with the bolt.
Torque: 20 N*m (199 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
HO
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
GD–1
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
REGISTRATION
1.
These
Switches
LED
B056159E01
REGISTRATION TRANSMITTER CODE
HINT:
The garage door opener is built into the dome light
assembly No. 1. If replacing the dome light assembly No.
1, codes for any systems previously registered in the
garage door opener must be re-registered.
(a) Re-register systems in the garage door opener
registration mode.
NOTICE:
• When registering a code in a garage door
opener system, a garage door or other device
may operate. In order to prevent injury or
damage, make sure that people and objects
are out of the way of the garage door or other
device.
• Before transmitter code registration, confirm
that all the electrical systems (headlight,
blower motor, rear defogger, etc.) are turned
off and no key is in the vehicle.
• The garage door opener cannot be used with
systems that: 1) were manufactured before
April 1, 1982; or 2) do not meet Federal
Standards (for example, garage doors without
a jam protection function).
HINT:
• 3 transmitter codes can be registered with the
garage door opener, one transmitter code for
each of the 3 garage door opener switches.
• Disconnecting the battery will not erase the
transmitter codes registered with the garage door
opener.
• An attempt to overwrite a previously registered
transmitter code with a new system's transmitter
code may fail. In these situations, the previously
registered transmitter code will not be erased.
(1) Select a garage door opener switch for
transmitter code registration.
(2) Press and hold the selected switch for 20
seconds. The garage door opener will enter
registration mode.
HINT:
Before entering registration mode, the LED is
ON. After entering registration mode, the LED
flashes at a cycle of 1 Hz. For a" rolling code"
type system, after entering registration mode,
the LED flashes at a cycle of 8.8 Hz for 1.6
seconds, and then the LED flashes at a cycle of
1 Hz.
GD
GD–2
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
Press
Original
Transmitter
GD
B056160E01
(3) After the garage door opener has entered
registration mode, bring the original transmitter
of the system to be registered within 1 inch of
the garage door opener switches. Then press
the original transmitter switch.
(4) If the transmitter code registration was
successful, the LED of the garage door opener
flashes at a cycle of 5.6 Hz. If no malfunction
occurs, release both the garage door opener
switch and the original transmitter switch.
HINT:
• If the code registration has failed, the battery
of the original transmitter may be weak or
the system may not meet the garage door
opener. In this case, press the original
transmitter repeatedly. Some transmitters
may need 1 to 2 seconds to stop
transmitting signals.
• If the transmitter code registration has not
been completed in 90 seconds after the
garage door opener has entered registration
mode, the garage door opener will enter low
power mode (See procedure "A").
(5) Timing chart of registration mode:
Timing chart of registration mode :
Garage Door
Opener Switch
PRESSED
RELEASED
ENTER
Registration
Mode
LED
Operation
20 sec.
EXIT
ON
OFF
LED flashes
at a cycle of 1 Hz
ON
Original
Transmitter
LED flashes
at a cycle of 5.6 Hz
OFF
I003487E11
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
GD–3
(b) Erase transmitter codes in the garage door opener
clear mode.
HINT:
• All 3 registered transmitter codes will be erased
at the same time (maximum 3 codes).
• If the switches are released within 10 seconds
after the transmitter codes have been erased, the
garage door opener will enter registration mode.
• If the switches are held for 10 seconds or more
after the transmitter codes have been erased,
default codes will be set to the switches of the
garage door opener. Using these default codes,
operation of the garage door opener can be
checked using a Home Link tester.
(1) Press and hold the 2 switches of the garage
door opener for 20 seconds. The LED will begin
to flash at a cycle of 5.6 Hz. Releasing the
switches will end clear mode.
(2) Timing chart of clear mode:
These
Switches
LED
B056159E01
Timing chart of clear mode :
Garage Door
Opener Switches
(at both ends)
PRESSED
Enter clear mode to erase all
3 codes
RELEASED
Load Default Code
ON
20 sec.
Clear Mode / Default Mode
10 sec.
OFF
LED Operation
ON
OFF
LED flashes at a cycle of 5.6 Hz
A053171E09
(c) Low power mode (Procedure "A"):
(1) If the garage door opener switch is held for 100
seconds or more, the garage door opener will
enter low power mode to economize on power
consumption. When the garage door opener
has entered low power mode, the LED turns
off.
GD
GD–4
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
These
Switches
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT GARAGE DOOR OPENER
(a) Press the switch and check that each red LED turns
on. If one or more of the switches does not turn on
the LED, confirm normal operation of the fuse and
wire harness, then replace the garage door opener
system unit.
2.
INSPECT GARAGE DOOR OPENER REGISTRATION
AND TRANSMITTING
HINT:
Use the home link tester made by KENT MORE for this
test. Because it is necessary to register the code of the
hand-held transmitter, the customer's code should be
erased. When the inspection is complete, register the
customer's again.
LED
GD
B056159E01
(a) Check if the tester transmitter code was
successfully registered.
HINT:
If the code cannot be registered, replace the garage
door opener system unit.
Press
Original
Transmitter
B056160E01
(b) Press the garage door opener switch that was
registered to the tester transmitter. Check if the
"Home Link" tester's green LED illuminates.
HINT:
If the green LED does not illuminate, replace the
garage door opener.
Garage Door Opener
Press
Home Link Tester
B062199E02
WS–4
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedures on the
following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
WS
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
NEXT
3
DTC CHECK
(a) Check for DTCs and make a note of the code that is
output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
HINT:
See page WS-12
(c) Check if the DTC will be output once again when the
problem symptom is simulated based on the noted code.
(1) With an output of the code, proceed to A.
(2) Without an output of the code, proceed to B.
A
GO TO STEP 5
B
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
See page WS-7
NEXT
5
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Operation check.
HINT:
See page WS-5
(b) Circuit inspection.
NEXT
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
6
WS–5
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
(a) If any of the power window switch illuminations is
blinking after repair, reset the power window.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Open the driver side door glass.
(3) Fully pull up the AUTO switch of the power window
master switch until the door glass is fully closed.
(4) Check that the AUTO UP/DOWN function operates
normally.
NEXT
END
OPERATION CHECK
1.
B066761
2.
CHECK WINDOW LOCK SWITCH
(a) Check that the operation of the door glasses except
the driver side door glass and the back door glass
and the roof glass is disabled when the window lock
switch of the power window master switch is
pressed.
(b) Check that the door glasses, the back door glass
and the roof glass can be operated when the
window lock switch is pressed again.
CHECK MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION (FOR
EXCEPT BACK DOOR)
(a) Check that the door glass can be operated using the
master switch as follows.
Standard
Condition
Master Switch
Ignition switch ON
AUTO
Switch Operation
Power Window
Pull halfway up
UP (Closed)
Push halfway down
DOWN (Open)
(b) Check that each door glass can be operated using
each power window switch as follows.
Standard
Condition
Master Switch
Passenger side
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Window lock switch OFF
Rear LH
Rear RH
Switch Operation
Power Window
Pull up
UP (Closed)
Push down
DOWN (Open)
Pull up
UP (Closed)
Push down
DOWN (Open)
Pull up
UP (Closed)
Push down
DOWN (Open)
WS
WS–6
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
3.
CHECK MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION (FOR BACK
DOOR)
(a) Check that the back door glass can be operated
using the back power window switch as follows.
Standard
Condition
•Ignition switch ON
•Window lock switch OFF
•Rear wiper is retracted
Master Switch
Manual
4.
WS
Switch Operation
Power Window
Press on up side within 0.3 sec.
UP (Closed)
Press on down side within 0.3
sec.
DOWN (Open)
CHECK AUTO UP/DOWN FUNCTION (FOR EXCEPT
BACK DOOR)
(a) Check that the driver side power window can be
operated using the AUTO (driver side) switch of the
power window master switch as follows:
Standard
Condition
Master Switch
Ignition switch ON
AUTO
5.
Switch Operation
Power Window
Pull halfway up
AUTO UP (Fully closed)
Push halfway down
AUTO DOWN (Fully open)
CHECK MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION (FOR BACK
DOOR)
(a) Check that the back door glass can be operated
using the back power window switch as follows.
Standard
Condition
•Ignition switch ON
•Window lock switch OFF
•Rear wiper is retracted
Master Switch
Manual
6.
Switch Operation
Power Window
Press on up side within 0.3 sec.
UP (fully closed)
Press on down side within 0.3
sec.
DOWN (Fully open)
CHECK REMOTE MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the door glasses other than the driver
side door glass can be operated using the master
switch as follows.
Standard
Condition
Master Switch
Passenger side
•
•
Ignition switch ON
Window lock switch OFF
Rear LH
Rear RH
7.
Switch Operation
Power Window
Pull up
UP (Closed)
Push down
DOWN (Open)
Pull up
UP (Closed)
Push down
DOWN (Open)
Pull up
UP (Closed)
Push down
DOWN (Open)
CHECK MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION VIA BACK
DOOR LOCK KEY CYLINDER (FOR BACK DOOR)
(a) Check that the back door glass can be operated
using the back power window switch as follows.
Standard
Condition
Rear wiper is retracted
Master Switch
Manual
Switch Operation
Power Window
Turn right (LOCK) for more
than 0.75 sec.
UP (Closed)
Turn left (UNLOCK) for more
than 0.75 sec.
DOWN (Open)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
8.
WS–7
CHECK POWER WINDOW OPERATION FUNCTION
AFTER IGNITION SWITCH IS TURNED OFF
(a) When both of the following conditions are fulfilled,
check that the door glasses, the back door glass
and the roof glass can be operated even after the
ignition switch is turned OFF:
• Within 45 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned OFF.
• The driver side door is closed.
9.
Hammer
B051853E01
CHECK JAM PROTECTION FUNCTION (DRIVER
SIDE)
HINT:
The jam protection function prevents any part of your
body from getting caught by accident between the door
frame and the door glass during power window
operation.
(a) Check that the door glass goes down by
approximately 50 mm (2.0 in.) right when something
gets caught between the door frame and door glass
during power window operation. However, when the
opening amount between the vehicle body and the
door glass is less than 200 mm (7.9 in.), the door
glass keeps going down until the opening amount
reaches 200 mm (7.9 in.) and stops there.
• AUTO UP
• AUTO UP operation after the ignition switch OFF
• MANUAL UP operation after the ignition switch
OFF
10. CHECK POWER WINDOW FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) If the pulse sensor of the power window motor
malfunctions, the power window functions will be
restricted:
• The AUTO UP/DOWN and the remote UP/
DOWN functions are disabled.
• The manual UP/DOWN function can be
performed via each power window switch.
WS
WS–8
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM (FOR EXCEPT BACK DOOR)
Symptom
AUTO UP/DOWN function does not operate
Remote UP/DOWN function does not operate
Manual UP/DOWN function does not operate on driver
side
WS
Manual UP/DOWN function does not operate on
passenger side
Manual UP/DOWN function does not operate on rear
LH
Manual UP/DOWN function does not operate on rear
RH
Power window do not operate at all
Door glass does down during AUTO UP operation
Suspected area
See page
1. Power window regulator motor assembly LH (Driver side)
WS-17
2. Wire harness
WS-17
3. Power window regulator master switch assembly
WS-17
1. Power window regulator motor assembly LH (Driver side)
WS-20
2. Wire harness
WS-20
3. Power window regulator master switch assembly
WS-20
1. Power window regulator master switch assembly
-
2. Power window regulator motor assembly LH (Driver side)
-
3. Wire harness
-
1. Power window regulator switch assembly (Passenger side)
WS-26
2. Power window regulator motor assembly RH (Passenger
side)
WS-26
3. Wire harness
WS-26
1. Power window regulator switch assembly rear (Rear LH)
WS-29
2. Power window regulator motor assembly RH (Rear LH)
WS-29
3. Wire harness
WS-29
1. Power window regulator switch assembly rear (Rear RH)
WS-32
2. Power window regulator motor assembly RH (Rear RH)
WS-32
3. Wire harness
WS-32
1. POWER fuse
WS-35
2. Power window relay
WS-35
3. Power window regulator master switch assembly
WS-35
4. Wire harness
WS-35
5. Instrument panel J/B assembly
WS-35
1. Front door glass run LH
-
2. Front door window glass LH
-
3. Front door window regulator sub-assembly LH
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM (FOR BACK DOOR)
Symptom
AUTO UP/DOWN function does not operate
Door glass down during AUTO/UP operation
Manual UP/DOWN function does not operate
Manual UP/DOWN function via back door lock key
cylinder does not operate
Suspected area
See page
1. Power window regulator motor assembly LH (Back door)
WS-15
2. Wire harness
WS-15
1. Back door glass run
WS-38
2. Back door power window regulator motor assembly LH
(Back door)
WS-38
3. Back door glass
WS-38
1. Rear wiper motor assembly
WS-23
2. Power window regulator motor assembly LH (Back door)
WS-23
3. Wire harness
WS-23
4. Multiplex network door ECU (Back door ECU)
WS-23
1. Back door lock key cylinder assembly
WS-39
2. Wire harness
WS-39
3. Multiplex network door ECU (Back door ECU)
WS-39
WS–9
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (BODY ECU)
B4
B5
B6
B6
B5
WS
B4
B062914E02
(a) Check the voltage or resistance between the
terminals of the connectors.
Standard
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
•
•
BUP (B5-10) ←→ COM (B5-19)
Y-R ←→ B-Y
Ignition switch ON
Back door power window
switch UP
Back door power window
switch OFF
•
•
BDN (B5-8) ←→ COM (B5-19)
W/L1 (B6-24) ←→ W/L2 (B6-22)
B-L ←→ B-Y
L-Y ←→ L-R
Ignition switch ON
Back door power window
switch DOWN
Specified Condition
Less than 1.5 V
More than 5 kΩ
Less than 1.5 V
Back door power window
switch OFF
More than 5 kΩ
Window lock switch ON
Less than 1.0 V
Window lock switch OFF
More than 1 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, the instrument panel
J/B assembly (body ECU) malfunctions.
WS–10
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
B9
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU (BACK
DOOR ECU)
B8
WS
B134204E02
(a) Check the voltage or continuity between the
terminals of the connectors.
Standard
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
BDR (B8-4) ←→ Body ground
L ←→ -
Constant
10 to 14 V
BECU (B8-5) ←→ Body ground
L-R ←→ -
SIG (B8-6) ←→ Body ground
B ←→ -
SGND (B9-18) ←→ GND (B8-3)
G-R ←→ W-B
GND (B8-3) ←→ Body ground
Constant
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch OFF
Less than 1 V
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
Constant
Continuity
W-B ←→ -
Constant
Continuity
BDUP (B9-13) ←→ BDDN (B925)
Y-B ←→ R-B
Back door power window in
close operation
10 to 14 V
BDDN (B9-25) ←→ BDUP (B913)
R-B ←→ Y-B
Back door power window in
open operation
10 to 14 V
IC+ (B9-11) ←→ IC- (B9-23)
Y-G ←→ L-W
Constant
6 to 14 V
IC1 (B9-16) ←→ IC- (B9-23)
B-O ←→ L-W
Back door power window in
operation
Pulse generates
IC2 (B9-17) ←→ IC- (B9-23)
W-R ←→ L-W
Back door power window in
operation
Pulse generates
UP (B9-5) ←→ E (B9-19)
V-Y ←→ LG-B
Back door lock key cylinder
turned right using key
Continuity
DOWN (B9-4) ←→ E (B9-19)
GR-R ←→ LG-B
Back door lock key cylinder
turned left using key
Continuity
E (B9-19) ←→ SGND (B9-18)
LG-B ←→ G-R
Constant
Continuity
P (B9-12) ←→ SGND (B9-18)
P-B ←→ G-R
Rear wiper in retract position
Less than 1 V
If the result is not as specified, the multiplex network
door ECU back (back door ECU) malfunctions.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–11
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
2.
USING INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Monitor the ECU data by following the prompts on
the tester screen.
HINT:
The intelligent tester has a "Snapshot" function
which records the monitored data. Refer to the
intelligent tester operator's manual for further
details.
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the DATA LIST displayed on the intelligent tester,
the value of the switch, sensor, actuator, etc. can be read
without part removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first
step of troubleshooting is one way to shorten the labor
time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the engine switch on (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
BACK DOOR ECU:
Item
Measurement Item/ Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
WIPER RTRCT SW
Rear wiper retract switch/ON or
OFF
ON: Rear wiper retract switch is
in ON position
OFF: Rear wiper retract switch is
in OFF position
-
KEY SW (UNLK)
Rear door lock key switch at
UNLOCK position/ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock key switch at
UNLOCK is in ON position
OFF: Rear door lock key switch at
UNLOCK is in OFF position
-
KEY SW (LOCK)
Rear door lock key switch at
LOCK position/ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock key switch at
LOCK is in ON position
OFF: Rear door lock key switch at
LOCK is in OFF position
-
P/W POSITION
Back door glass position/CLOSE
or OPEN
CLOSE: Back door glass is in
CLOSE position
OPEN: Back door glass is in
OPEN position
-
Door glass position (Fully closed 1/4 open) signal/OK or CAUTION
OK: Power window is going UP
by manual operation
CAUTION: CAUTION may be
displayed when resistance is
applied in each position. In this
case, there must be a foreign
object stuck in that position
-
Door glass position (1/4 open - 2/
4 open) signal/OK or CAUTION
OK: Power window is going UP
by manual operation
CAUTION: CAUTION may be
displayed when resistance is
applied in each position. In this
case, there must be a foreign
object stuck in that position
-
GLASS POS-1/4
GLASS POS-2/4
WS
WS–12
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Measurement Item/ Display
(Range)
Item
Door glass position (2/4 open - 3/
4 open) signal/OK or CAUTION
GLASS POS-3/4
Normal Condition
OK: Power window is going UP
by manual operation
CAUTION: CAUTION may be
displayed when resistance is
applied in each position. In this
case, there must be a foreign
object stuck in that position
Diagnostic Note
-
BODY:
Measurement Item/ Display
(Range)
Item
WS
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
IG SW
Engine switch signal/ ON or OFF
ON: Power source mode is on
(IG)
OFF: Power source mode is off or
on (ACC)
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal/ or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CYT SW
Front passenger side door
courtesy switch signal/ ON or
OFF
ON: Front passenger side door is
open
OFF: Front passenger side door
is closed
-
3.
-
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows you to operate the relay, VSV, actuator, etc.
without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
the first step of troubleshooting is one way to shorten the
labor time. It is possible to display the DATA LIST during
the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the engine switch on (IG).
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
BACK DOOR ECU
Item
Test Detail
Diagnostic Note
P/W UP/DOWN
Operates back door power window UP/
DOWN
-
WS–36
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Power Windows do not Operate at All
DESCRIPTION
If all the door glasses do not operate or if the operation function after the ignition switch is turned OFF
does not operate, no power may be supplied to the power window master switch or the power window
master switch itself may malfunction.
WIRING DIAGRAM
D17
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assembly
WS
Instrument Panel J/B Assembly
11
From Ignition Switch
B
7
Power Window Relay
POWER
From Battery
1
2
5
3
6
B
1
From Courtesy Switch
R
B2
BW
B
2
Body
ECU
From Ignition Switch
To Power Window Motor *1
To Power Window Motor *2
1
E
*1: Driver Side Power Window
*2: Power Window Ezcept Driver Side
B140740E02
WS–37
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (POWER)
(a) Remove the fuse from the instrument panel J/B
assembly.
(b) Check the continuity.
Standard:
Continuity
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
WS
INSPECT INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the power window relay.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the voltage between the J/B terminals 1 and 2.
Standard:
10 to 14 V
Power Window Relay
NG
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B
ASSEMBLY
B063172E01
OK
3
INSPECT POWER WINDOW RELAY (POWER)
1
5
3
1
2
2
5
(a) Remove the relay from the backside of the instrument
panel J/B assembly.
(b) Check the continuity.
(c) Check the voltage between the J/B terminals 1 and 2.
Standard
Terminal No.
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Constant
Continuity
3-5
Apply battery voltage to
terminal 1 and 2
Continuity
3
B060778E82
WS–38
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW RELAY
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TERMINAL B2, BW OR E)
(a) Disconnect the D17 switch connector.
(b) Check the voltage or continuity between each terminal of
the wire harness side connector and the body ground.
Standard
Wire Harness Side
D17 Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assembly
WS
B062895E13
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
B2 (D17-11) - Body
ground
Ignition ON
10 to 14 V
BW (D17-7) - Body
ground
Constant
10 to 14 V
E (D17-1) - Body ground
Constant
Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TERMINAL B)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check the voltage between terminal 6 of the wire
harness side connector and the body ground.
Standard
Wire Harness Side
D17 Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assembly
Terminal No.
Condition
Specified Condition
B (D17-6) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
OK
B062895E13
REPLACE POWER WINDOW MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (POWER WINDOW RELAY - MASTER
SWITCH)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–39
Back Door Glass goes Down During Auto Up Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the door glass or the power window regulator does not smoothly operate, the jam protection function
may operate abnormally, resulting in this symptom.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Open the back door glass.
(c) Press the back door power window switch until the door
glass is fully closed, and continue to hold the switch 1
second more even after the door glass is fully closed.
(d) Check that the AUTO UP/DOWN function operates
normally.
OK
END
NG
2
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR W/MOTOR
(a) Remove the back door glass.
(b) Operate the power window regulator via the back door
power window switch while the back door glass is not
installed.
(c) Check that the power window regulator operates
smoothly.
OK
REPLACE BACK DOOR GLASS RUN
NG
REPLACE BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
WS
WS–40
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function Via Back Door Lock Key Cylinder does not
Operate
DESCRIPTION
If the manual UP/DOWN function via the back door lock key cylinder does not operate, the back door lock
key cylinder or the wire harness may be abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
T10 Tail Gate Control Switch Assembly
(Back Door Lock Key Cylinder)
B9 Multiplex Network Door
ECU Back (Back Door ECU)
WS
UP 1
5
V-Y
2
4
DOWN
GR-R
3
19
LG-B
E
UP
DOWN
E
To Back Door Power Window Motor
B062910E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BACK DOOR WINDOW OPERATION
(a) Check that the back door power window operates via the
back door power window switch.
NG
OTHER PROBLEM
OK
2
INSPECT TAIL GATE CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (BACK DOOR LOCK KEY
CYLINDER)
(a) Disconnect the switch connector.
(b) Insert the key into the key cylinder.
(c) Check the continuity between the terminals of the switch
connector when turning the key.
Standard
Terminal No.
Operation
Specified Condition
1-3
Turn key to right
Continuity
1-2
No operation
No continuity
2-3
Turn key to left
Continuity
B062911E01
NG
REPLACE TAIL GATE CONTROL SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–41
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BACK DOOR ECU - SWITCH)
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–1
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
FOR EXCEPT BACK POWER WINDOW:
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY RH (PASSENGER SIDE)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY (PASSENGER SIDE)
INSTRUMENT PANEL
J/B ASSEMBLY
(BODY ECU)
POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH
(DRIVER SIDE)
POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY REAR
(REAR LH)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY RH (REAR RH)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY REAR (REAR RH)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB- ASSEMBLY LH (DRIVER SIDE)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH (REAR LH)
B120211E02
WS–2
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B ASSEMBLY:
(BODY ECU)
WS
VEHICLE REAR SIDE
POWER FUSE
VEHICLE FRONT SIDE
POWER WINDOW RELAY
B120212E02
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
FOR BACK POWER WINDOW:
WS–3
TAIL GATE CONTROL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(BACK DOOR LOCK KEY CYLINDER)
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B
ASSEMBLY (BODY ECU)
BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(WINDOW LOCK SWITCH)
MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
(BACK DOOR ECU)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY (BACK DOOR)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH (BACK DOOR)
B120210E02
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
WS–43
REMOVAL
1.
Windshield Glass
Moulding
Cut
Cut
Vehicle Body
B111429E01
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the front door weatherstrip LH.
(b) Remove the front door weatherstrip RH.
(c) Remove the 2 assist grips.
(d) Remove the front pillar garnish LH.
(e) Remove the front pillar garnish RH.
(f) Remove the LH Visor assembly.
(g) Remove the RH Visor assembly.
(h) Remove the LH visor.
(i) Remove the RH visor.
(j) Remove the 2 visor holders.
(k) Remove the roof console box assembly.
(l) Remove the roof headlining assembly.
2.
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
HINT:
See page MI-7
3.
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 front wiper arm head caps.
(b) Remove the FR wiper arm LH.
(c) Remove the FR wiper arm RH.
(d) Remove the front fender to cowl side seal LH.
(e) Remove the front fender to cowl side seal RH.
(f) Remove the cowl top ventilator louver.
4.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE LH
(See page WS-54)
5.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE RH
6.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTER UPPER
(a) Using a knife, cut off the moulding, as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the vehicle body with the knife.
(b) Remove the remaining moulding.
HINT:
When removing, make a partial a cut, then pull and
remove it by hand.
(c) w/ Deicer:
Disconnect the connector, as shown in the
illustration.
WS
WS–44
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
7.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Pass a piano wire between the vehicle body and
glass from the interior.
Stopper
Piano Wire
B062805E04
(b) Tie both wire ends to wooden blocks or similar
objects.
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the
vehicle body to prevent its surface from being
scratched.
NOTICE:
• When separating the glass from the vehicle,
be careful not to damage the vehicle's paint
or interior/exterior ornaments.
• To prevent the safety pad from being
scratched when removing the glass, place a
plastic sheet between the piano wire and
safety pad.
(c) Cut off the adhesive by pulling piano wire around
the glass.
(d) Disengage the stoppers.
(e) Using a suction cup, remove the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as
possible when removing the glass.
Protective Tape
WS
Plastic Sheet
B106959E01
8.
B106929
CLEAN WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Using a scraper, remove the damaged stoppers,
dams and adhesive sticking to the glass.
(b) Clean the outer circumference of the glass with
white gasoline.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning it.
WS–45
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
INSTALLATION
Backside:
1.
Ceramic Line
A
B
C
C
Stopper
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS NO. 2 STOPPER
(a) Coat the installation part of the stoppers with Primer
G.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer G for
later use.
• Do not apply too much Primer .
(b) Install 2 new stoppers onto the glass, as shown in
the illustration.
Dimension
B106960E01
A
40.0 mm (1.575 in.)
B
7.7 mm (0.303 in.)
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS NO. 1 STOPPER
(a) Install 2 new stoppers to the vehicle body, as shown
in the illustration.
3.
INSTALL WINDOW GLASS ADHESIVE DAM
(a) Coat the installation part of the windshield glass
adhesive dam with Primer G.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not apply too much Primer.
(b) Install a new dam, applying double-sided tape all
the way around the glass except where the stoppers
are installed, as shown in the illustration.
Vehicle Body
B106961E01
A
Measurement
2.
Stopper
Backside:
Area
A
A
A
A
B
Ceramic Line
B
b
Dam
C
C
A-A
B-B
Ceramic Line
Stopper
b
Dam
C-C
a
c
Ceramic End
B067566E01
WS
WS–46
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
Dimension
Area
Adhesive
Body
B106934E01
Mark
B111406E01
a
905 mm (0.375 in.)
c
31.4 mm (1.236 in.)
4.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTER UPPER
(a) Using the brush or sponge, coat the edge of the
glass and the contact surface with Primer G.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not coat the adhesive with Primer G.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer G for
later use.
(b) Install the moulding.
5.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) Using a knife, cut away any rough adhesive on
the contact surface of the vehicle body to
ensure the appropriate surface shape.
HINT:
Leave as much of the adhesive on the vehicle
body as possible.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body
with a piece of shop rag saturated with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed,
clean the vehicle body.
WS
Adhesive
Measurement
(b) Position the glass.
(1) Using a suction cup, place the glass in the
correct position.
(2) Check that the whole contact surface of the
glass rim is perfectly even.
(3) Place reference marks between the glass and
vehicle body.
NOTICE:
Check that the stoppers are attached to the
vehicle body correctly.
HINT:
When reusing the glass, check and correct the
reference mark positions.
(4) Remove the glass.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
CORRECT
Primer M
Primer M
WS–47
(c) Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the vehicle
body with Primer M.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not coat the adhesive with Primer M.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer M for
later use.
Adhesive
WRONG
WS
Primer M
B067819E03
Backside:
a
b
a
b
c
c
Primer G
a-a
b-b
c-c
Primer G
Primer G
B067567E01
(d) Using a brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass
and the contact surface with Primer G.
HINT:
If the area other than that specified is coated by
accident, wipe off the primer with a clean shop rag
before it dries.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer G for
later use.
WS–48
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
Backside:
A
B
B
A
C
(e) Apply adhesive (Adhesive: Part No.08850-00801 or
equivalent).
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle, as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time described in the table below.
Tackfree time
Temperature
C
a
A-A
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
b
WS
B-B
C-C
a
b
c
Usage Timeframe
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Coat the glass with adhesive, as shown in the
illustration.
Dimension
c
Ceramic End dB067568E02
(f)
Mark
B111406E01
Area
Measurement
a
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
b
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
c
3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
d
24.9 mm (0.980 in.)
Install the glass.
(1) Using a suction cup, position the glass so that
the reference marks are aligned. Press it in
gently along the rim.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3
minutes or more.
• Check that the stoppers are attached to
the vehicle body correctly.
• Check that clearance between the vehicle
body and glass.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the glass to
ensure a close fit.
(3) Using a scraper, remove any excess or
protruding adhesive.
HINT:
Apply adhesive on the glass rim.
Adhesive
B073131E02
WS–49
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of
time described in the table below.
Minimum time
Windshield
Dam
Adhesive
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
N008495E03
6.
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
WS
WS–51
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Symptom
Rear window defogger does not does not operate
(Indicator light ON)
Rear window defogger does not operate (Indicator
light OFF)
Suspected area
See page
1. DEFOG fuse
-
2. DEF relay
WS-54
3. Rear window defogger wire
WS-51
4. Wire harness
-
5. Instrument panel junction block assembly
-
1. DEFOG fuse
-
2. DEF relay
WS-54
3. Air conditioning control assembly
WS-53
4. Rear window defogger
WS-51
5. Wire harness
-
6. Instrument panel junction block assembly
-
WS
WS–52
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Defogger Wire
Tester Probe
WS
1.
CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
(a) When the engine switch is turned on (IG) and the
defogger switch is pressed, check that the rear
window defogger operates.
HINT:
After 15 minutes, check that the defogger
automatically turns OFF.
2.
INSPECT BACK WINDOW (DEFOGGER WIRE)
NOTICE:
• When cleaning the glass, wipe the glass along the
wire using a soft and dry cloth. Take care not to
damage the wires.
• Do not use detergents or glass cleaners that have
abrasive ingredients.
Tin Foil
B106755E01
• When measuring voltage, wrap a piece of tin foil
around the tip of the negative rester probe and
press the foil against the wire with your finger, as
shown in the illustration.
(a) Turn the engine switch on (IG).
(b) Turn the defogger switch ON.
At Center
B106756E01
0V
Foil Strip
Ground Side
(-)
Less than
10 V
Battery
Side
(+)
Broken Wire
B106757E01
(c) Check the voltage at the center of each defogger
wire, as shown in the illustration.
Standard voltage
Voltage
Criteria
Approx. 5 V
Wire is not broken
Approx. 10 or 0 V
Wire is broken
HINT:
If there is approximately 10 V, the wire may be faulty
between the center of the wire and the wire and on
the battery side. If there is no voltage, the wire may
be faulty between the center of the wire and the wire
end on the ground side.
(d) Place the voltmeter's positive (+) lead against the
defogger wire on the battery side.
(e) Place the voltmeter's negative (-) lead with the foil
strip against the wire on the ground side.
(f) Slide the positive (+) lead from the battery side to
the ground side.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WS–53
(g) The point where the voltage drops from
approximately 10 V to 0 V is the place where the
defogger wire is broken.
HINT:
If the defogger wire is not broken, the voltmeter
should indicate 0 V at the positive (+) end of the
defogger wire but gradually increases to
approximately 12 V as the meter probe moves to
the other end.
REPAIR
1.
Masking Tape
IF NECESSARY, REPAIR THE DEFOGGER WIRE
(a) Clean the broken wire tips with a grease, wax and
silicone remover.
(b) Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire.
Broken Wire
Repair Point
B106758E03
(c) Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817 or equivalent).
(d) Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount of the
agent to the wire.
(e) After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
NOTICE:
Do not repair the defogger wire again for at least
24 hours.
B106759
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WS–57
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart.
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY LH
2.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
3.
REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH
(a) Remove the deck board.
(b) Remove the deck board assembly.
(c) Remove the rear floor mat support plate.
(d) Remove the back door weatherstrip.
(e) Remove the rear door scuff plate LH.
(f) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip LH.
(g) Remove the luggage hold belt striker assembly.
(h) Remove deck trim cover rear.
(i) Remove the deck floor box LH
(j) Remove deck trim side panel assembly LH.
(k) Remove the quarter trim cover RH.
(l) Remove the tonneau cover hook B.
(m) Remove the roof side garnish assembly inner LH.
4.
Piano Wire
Stopper Cushion
Clip
Clip
Clip
B140741E01
REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Pass a piano wire through between the body and
glass from the interior.
WS
WS–58
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(c) Tie both wire ends to wooden blocks or similar
objects.
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the outer surface to prevent
the surface from being scratched.
NOTICE:
• When separating the glass, take care not to
damage the paint and the interior and exterior
ornaments.
• To prevent scratching the safety pad when
removing the glass, place a plastic sheet
between the piano wire and safety pad.
(d) Cut off the adhesive by pulling the piano wire
around the glass.
(e) Remove the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the body as
possible when removing the glass.
Protective Tape
WS
B140742E01
5.
CLEAN QUARTER WINDOW ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Clean the outer circumference of the glass with
white gasoline.
NOTICE:
• Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning
it.
• Be careful not to damage the glass.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WS–59
INSTALLATION
Adhesive
Adhesive
Body
B106934E01
1.
INSTALL STOPPER CUSHION
(a) Clean the installation area.
(b) Install 4 new spacers onto the glass.
2.
INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) Using a knife, cut away any rough adhesive on
the contact surface of the vehicle body to
ensure the appropriate surface shape.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body
as possible.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body
with a piece of shop rag saturated with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed,
clean the vehicle body.
(b) Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the vehicle
body on the vehicle side with Primer M.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not coat the adhesive with Primer M.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer M for
later use.
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
B111407E01
WS
WS–60
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(c) Using brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass
and the contact surface with Primer G.
a
a
b
b
c
d-d
A
B
WS
b-b
c-c
A
20.0 mm (0.787 in.)
B
26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
C
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
d
d
c
a-a
A
A
HINT:
If an area other than that specified is coated by
accident, wipe off the primer with a clean shop rag
before it dries.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer G for
later use.
: Primer G
B063580E01
Backside
a
a
b
d
b
d
c
c
a-a
B
d-d
A
D
E
B
Temperature
Usage Timeframe
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Coat the glass with adhesive, as shown in the
illustration.
Specification
b-b
A
(d) Apply adhesive (Adhesive: Part No. 08850-00801 or
equivalent).
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle, as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time described in the table below.
Usage timeframe
c-c
Area
Measurement
A
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
B
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
C
13.0 mm (0.512 in.)
D
13.0 mm (0.512 in.)
E
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
(e) Install the quarter window to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the quarter window in place securely with
protective tape or equivalent until the adhesive
hardens.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3
minutes or more.
: Adhesive
B062849E01
WS–61
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
• Check that the spacers are attached to
the vehicle body correctly.
• Check that the vehicle body and glass
have a small gap between them.
(2) Lightly press the front surface for close contact.
(3) Using a scraper, remove any excess or
protruding adhesive.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of
time described in the table below.
Adhesive
WS
B073131E02
Minimum time
Windshield
Dam
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
3.
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
4.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH
5.
INSTALL REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER
LH (w/ Rear No. 2 Seat)
Adhesive
N008495E03
WS–13
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM (FOR BACK DOOR WINDOW)
DTC No.
Detection Item
Suspected Part
B1241
Body ECU Switch Circuit
Diagnosis
1. Back door power window
regulator switch assembly
2. Defogger switch relay
3. Rear wiper switch relay
4. Wire harness
B2221
Jam Protection Pulse Sensor
Circuit on Back Door
1. Power window regulator motor
assembly LH (Back door)
2. Wire harness
See page
WS-13
WS-15
WS
WS–14
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
B1241
Body ECU Switch Circuit Diagnosis
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1241 is output when the back door power window switch, the defogger switch and the rear power
window switch are on. When these switches are off, this DTC is not output.
Using this DTC, you can check whether these switches are normal or not.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Suspected Part
•
B1241
WS
Back door power window switch, defogger switch and
rear wiper switch are operating
•
•
•
Back door power window regulator switch
assembly
Defogger switch assembly
Rear wiper switch assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
B1
Back Door Power Window
Regulator Switch Assembly
B5
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
DOWN 6
B-L
8
UP 3
Y-R
10
E 1
B-Y
19
BDN
BUP
COM
B062903E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW OPERATION
(a) Check that the back door power window operates via the
back door power window switch.
OK
NG
INSPECT DEFOGGER SWITCH OR REAR
WIPER SWITCH
WS–15
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
2
INSPECT BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the power window switch.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the switch
connector when the switch is operated.
Standard
Terminal No.
Switch
Specified Condition
3 ←→ 1
Down
Continuity
6 ←→ 3 ←→ 1
OFF
No continuity
6 ←→ 1
Up
Continuity
B062904
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (SWITCH - BODY ECU)
NG
REPLACE BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
WS–41
WINDSHIELD GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
WS
RH VISOR ASSEMBLY
ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
LH VISOR ASSEMBLY
VISOR HOLDER
RH VISOR
VISOR HOLDER
INNER REAR VIEW
MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH VISOR
WITH ELECTRO CHROMIC MIRROR:
MIRROR COVER
INNER REAR VIEW
MIRROR ASSEMBLY
B120220E02
WS–42
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP RH
WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE RH
WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTER UPPER
CLIP
WINDOW GLASS ADHESIVE DAM
WINDSHIELD GLASS NO. 1 STOPPER
WINDSHIELD GLASS NO. 2 STOPPER
WS
WINDSHIELD MOULDING
OUTSIDE LH
ASSIST GRIP
ASSIST GRIP
FRONT DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP
LH
WINDSHIELD GLASS
CLIP
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
FR WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
FR WIPER ARM RH
FR WIPER ARM LH
FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
20 (204, 15)
FRONT FENDER TO
COWL SIDE SEAL RH
FRONT FENDER TO COWL SIDE SEAL LH
COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120221E02
WS–16
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
B2221
Jam Protection Pulse Sensor Circuit on Back
Door
DESCRIPTION
The back door ECU monitors the condition of the power window motor and detects the position of the
door glass by using pulse signals output from the 2 pulse sensors in the power window motor.
DTC No.
B2221
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
•
•
•
WS
PLS pulse sensor circuit malfunction
PLS2 pulse sensor circuit malfunction
Pulse direction is opposite to motor rotating
direction (Short circuit between PLS and PLS2)
PLS and PLS2 pulse sensors circuit malfunction
Fully closed position is misaligned
Suspected Part
•
•
Power window regulator motor assembly LH (Back
door)
Wire harness
FAIL-SAFE
If the pulse sensor in the back door power window motor malfunctions (DTC B2221 is output), the power
window functions will be restricted:
• The AUTO UP/ DOWN function is disabled.
• The MANUAL DOWN function via the transmitter is disabled.
• The MANUAL UP/DOWN function via the back door power window switch can be performed (the
ignition switch ON).
• The MANUAL UP/DOWN function via the back door lock key cylinder can be performed (the ignition
switch ON).
WIRING DIAGRAM
B11
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Back Door)
B9
Multiplex Network
Door ECU Back
SSRB
1
Y-G
11
PLS
2
W-R
17
PLS2
6
B-O
16
3
L-W
23
PLS
PLS2
E
IC+
IC2
IC1
IC-
B062902E07
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–17
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Open the back door glass.
(c) Press the back door power window switch until the door
glass is fully closed, and continue to hold the switch 1
second more even after the door glass is fully closed.
(d) Check that the AUTO UP/DOWN function operates
normally.
OK
END
WS
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BACK DOOR ECU - WINDOW MOTOR) (BACK DOOR ECU BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side:
B9
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B9 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the B11 motor connector.
(c) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
B9-23 ←→ B11-3
Continuity
B9-17 ←→ B11-2
Continuity
B9-16 ←→ B11-6
Continuity
B9-11 ←→ B11-1
Continuity
(d) Check the continuity between the B9 ECU connector and
the body ground.
Standard
B11
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Back Door)
B062905E01
OK
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
B9-11 ←→ Body ground
No continuity
B9-16 ←→ Body ground
No continuity
B9-17 ←→ Body ground
No continuity
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WS–49
WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
WS
ENGINE ROOM R/B NO. 2:
DEFOGGER FUSE
(MARKING: DEFOG)
DEFOGGER RELAY
(MARKING: DEF)
MIRRO HEATER FUSE
(MARKING: MIR HEATER)
B120223E02
WS–50
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY:
DEFOGGER SWITCH
WS
WITH OUTER MIRROR HEATER:
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY RH
INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER WIRE
- BODY ECU
WITH OUTER MIRROR HEATER:
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
ASSEMBLY LH
B134259E02
WS–18
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Auto Up / Down Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
WS
If the AUTO UP/DOWN function does not operate, any of the following troubles may be the cause:
• When the PWR fuse or the power window relay (Marking: PWR) is replaced with new ones, or when
the battery terminal and the connector of the power window master switch are disconnected, the power
window memory of the fully closed position which is recorded in the power window master switch is
erased.
• The pulse sensors in the driver side power window motor have a malfunction.
• There is an open or short circuit in the wiring between the power window master switch and the driver
side power window motor.
• The power window master switch has a malfunction.
WIRING DIAGRAM
P12
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Driver Side)
PLS
PLS2
D17
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assembly
SSRB
4
W-L
3
PLS
5
W-R
14
PLS2 3
W-G
17
E
BR-B
2
6
VCC
PLS
PLS2
GND
B062902E14
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION (DRIVER SIDE)
(a) Check that the door glass can be operated manually.
NG
OK
OTHER PROBLEM
WS–19
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
2
CHECK ILLUMINATION OF POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Operate the AUTO (drive side) switch of the master
switch.
(c) Check the blinking pattern of the AUTO light as shown in
the illustration.
(1) If pattern (1) is displayed, proceed to A.
(2) If pattern (2) or (3) is displayed, proceed to B.
(3) If the normal pattern is displayed, proceed to C.
WS
B067295
Blinking Pattern of AUTO Light:
(1): Fully closed
position is misaligned
(3): Both (1) and (2)
(2): Pulse sensor
circuit malfunction
Normal
ON
OFF
(AUTO Light)
1.5
2.0
(sec.)
0.5
1.0
(sec.)
1.0 1.5
2.0
(sec.)
0.5
B128873E01
B
C
Go to step 4
REPLACE POWER WINDOW MASTER
SWITCH
A
3
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Open the door glass.
(c) Fully pull up the AUTO switch of the power window
master switch until the door glass is fully closed.
(d) Check that the AUTO UP/DOWN function operates
normally.
OK
NG
END
WS–20
4
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the D17 master switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P12 motor connector (driver side).
(c) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
D17
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assembly
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
D17-4 - P12-5
D17-17 - P12-3
D17-3 - P12-4
WS
Continuity
D17-2 - P12-6
D17-2 - P12-3
P12
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Driver Side)
D17-2 - P12-4
No continuity
D17-2 - P12-5
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B062894E02
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH (DRIVER SIDE)
WS–53
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(DEFOGGER SWITCH)
(a) Inspect operation of the defogger switch indicator.
Standard
Measurement Condition
B063893E01
Battery positive (+) - IG+ (2)
Battery negative (-) - DIND (11)
Specified Condition
Indicator light comes up
If the result is not as specified, replace the air
conditioning control assembly.
(b) Inspect the defogger switch continuity.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
4-7
ON
Continuity
4-7
OFF
No continuity
If the result is not as specified, replace the air
conditioning control assembly.
Switch ON
B063894E01
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–21
Remote Up / Down Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
If the REMOTE UP/DOWN function does not operate, any of the following troubles may be the cause:
• When the POWER fuse and the POWER relay are replaced with new ones, or when the battery
terminal and the connectors of the power window master switch are disconnected, the power window
memory of the fully closed position which is recorded in the power window master switch is erased.
• The pulse sensors in the driver side power window motor have a malfunction.
• There is an open or short circuit in the wiring between the power window master switch and the
applicable power window switch.
• The power window master switch has a malfunction.
WS
WIRING DIAGRAM
P11
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assembly Rear (Rear RH)
SD
SU
2
G
5 G-B
D17
Power Window Regulator Master Switch Assembly
6
BB1
G
10
IA2
7
BB1
G-B
11
IA2
R-L 16
B
18
RRD
RRU
P10
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assembly Rear (Rear LH)
SD
SU
2
G-R
6
BA1
G-R
6
IA2
G
10
5
G-W
11
BA1
G-W
9
IA2
L
12
RLD
RLU
P9
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assembly (Passenger Side)
J/C
SD
SU
2 R
5
R-B
5
IP2
L-R
A
J22
A
L-R
J22
12
IA2
R
9
IP2
L-Y
B
J22
B
J22
7
IA2
R-B 13
L-Y
15
PD
PU
B067292E02
WS–22
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUTO DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the AUTO UP/DOWN function operates
normally.
NG
OTHER PROBLEM
OK
WS
2
CHECK POWER WINDOW LOCK SWITCH
(a) Push the window lock switch OFF (normal) and check
that the remote UP/DOWN function operates.
OK
END
B066761
NG
3
CHECK MANUAL UP/DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Inspect the switch with which the remote function cannot
be operated.
NG
OTHER PROBLEM
OK
4
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
HINT:
Inspect the switch with the nonoperational remote function.
(a) Remove the master switch.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the master
switch connector when the switch is operated.
Standard resistance:
Passenger side switch
B060766
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Window Lock Switch
Power Window Switch
Terminal No.
UP
1 - 15, 6 - 13
OFF (Normal)
OFF
1 - 13 - 15
DOWN
1 - 13, 6 - 15
UP
6 - 13
OFF
13 - 15
DOWN
6 - 15
ON (Lock)
WS–23
Specified Condition
Continuity
Rear RH switch
Window Lock Switch
Power Window Switch
Terminal No.
UP
1 - 16, 6 - 18
OFF (Normal)
OFF
1 - 6 - 18
DOWN
1 - 18, 6 - 16
UP
6 - 18
OFF
16 - 18
DOWN
6 - 16
ON (Lock)
Specified Condition
Continuity
Rear LH switch
Window Lock Switch
OFF (Normal)
ON (Lock)
Power Window Switch
Terminal No.
UP
1 - 10, 6 - 12
OFF
1 - 10 - 12
DOWN
1 - 12, 6 - 10
UP
6 - 12
OFF
10 - 12
DOWN
6 - 10
NG
Specified Condition
Continuity
REPLACE POWER WINDOW MASTER
SWITCH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (MASTER SWITCH - EACH REGULATOR
SWITCH)
WS
WS–54
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – DEFOGGER RELAY
DEFOGGER RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DEFOGGER RELAY (Marking: DEFOG)
(a) Measure the resistance of the DEFOG relay.
Standard
Tester Condition
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
(when battery voltage is not applied
between terminals)
3 -5
Continuity
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
B057491E07
WS
Specified Condition
1-2
If the result is not as specified, replace the
relay.
WS–24
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Back Door Only
DESCRIPTION
If the back door power window does not operate, the retract switch in the rear wiper motor, the back door
power window motor or the wire harness may be abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
B11 Back Door Power Window
Regulator Motor Assembly
Multiplex Network
Door ECU Back
25
B9 BDDN
5
WS
R-B
Body ECU
Back Power
Window Switch
13
B9 BDUP
4
Y-B
Multiplex
Communication
R23 Rear Wiper
Motor Assembly
Retract SW
1
P-B
2
G-R
12
B9
P
18
B9
SGND
B062906E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK REAR WIPER OPERATION
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Operate the rear wiper and turn the rear wiper switch
OFF.
(c) Check that the rear wiper stops at the retract position
when the rear wiper switch is turned OFF.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE BACK DOOR POWER
WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY
B062907E01
OK
2
INSPECT BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Using the hand?held tester, read the DTC when the back
power window switch is operated.
(1) When DTC B1287 is output, proceed to A.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–25
(2) When no DTC is output, proceed to B.
(3) When DTC B1241 is output, proceed to C.
A
INSPECT MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
B
INSPECT BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
C
3
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Check the condition of the retract switch using the data
list.
Standard:
Data list for back door ECU
Measurement Item
Label
Perameter
Wiper retract switch
WIPER RTRCT SW
ON
NG
Go to step 6
OK
4
WIRE HARNESS (BACK DOOR ECU - POWER WINDOW MOTOR) (BACK DOOR ECU GROUND)
Wire Harness Side:
B9
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B9 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the B11 motor connector.
(c) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
B9-25 - B11-5
Continuity
B9-13 - B11-4
Continuity
(d) Check the continuity between the B9 ECU connector and
the body ground.
Standard
B11
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Back Door)
NG
B062905E02
OK
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
B9-13 - Body ground
No continuity
B9-25 - Body ground
No continuity
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
WS
WS–26
5
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY
Counterclockwise
(a) Remove the motor.
(b) Apply battery voltage between the connector terminals
and check that the motor gear rotates smoothly.
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to any terminals except
terminals 4 and 5.
Standard
Terminal No.
Clockwise
WS
B062908E01
Specified Condition
Battery positive voltage → 5
Battery negative voltage → 4
Counterclockwise
Battery positive voltage → 4
Battery negative voltage → 5
Clockwise
NG
REPLACE BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BACK DOOR ECU - POWER WINDOW MOTOR) (BACK DOOR
ECU - GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the B9 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the B23 motor connector.
(c) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard
Wire Harness Side:
B9
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
B9-12 - R23-1
Continuity
B9-18 - R23-2
Continuity
(d) Check the continuity between the B9 ECU connector and
the body ground.
Standard
R23
Rear Wiper Motor Assembly
NG
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
B9-12 - Body ground
No continuity
B9-18 - Body ground
No continuity
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B062909E02
OK
REPLACE BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WS–55
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
WS
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
COVER
COVER
DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
DECK BOARD
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER ASSEMBLY
DECK TRIM COVER NO. 1
B120222E02
WS–56
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER LH
COVER
WS
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER ASSEMBLY
42 (428, 31)
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
QUARTER TRIM COVER LH
TONNEAU COVER HOOK B
STOPPER
CUSHION
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL
ASSEMBLY LH
QUARTER WINDOW
ASSEMBLY RR LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B134258E02
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–27
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Passenger Side Only
DESCRIPTION
If the manual UP/DOWN function does not operate, the power window motor, the power window switch or
the wire harness is abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
P13
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly RH (Passenger Side)
P9
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly (Passenger Side)
WS
2
L-B
1
D
1
L
3
U
4
B
2
SD
5
SU
B
From Power Window Relay
To Power Window Master Switch (Ground)
To Power Window Master Switch (Ground)
B062900E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
P9
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly
(Passenger Side)
(a) Disconnect the P9 switch connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the voltage between terminal 4 of the wire
harness side connector of the switch and the body
ground.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
NG
B062901E07
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (SWITCH - RELAY)
WS–28
2
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY (PASSENGER SIDE)
(a) Remove the power window switch.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the switch
connector when the switch is operated.
Standard resistance
WS
Terminal No.
Switch
1 - 2, 3 - 4
UP
1 - 2, 3 - 5
OFF
1 - 4, 3 - 5
DOWN
Specified Condition
Continuity
B063163E12
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - MOTOR) (SWITCH - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P13 motor connector.
(b) Check the continuity between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
P9
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assembly (Passenger Side)
Terminal No.
P9-1 - P13-1
P9-3 - P13-2
Specified Condition
Continuity
(c) Check the continuity between the P9 switch connector
and the body ground.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
P13
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly RH (Passenger Side)
P9-1 - Body ground
P9-3 - Body ground
NG
B063164E06
OK
Specified Condition
No continuity
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
4
WS–29
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY RH
Motor Gear
(a) Remove the motor.
(b) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and 2.
(c) Check that the motor rotates smoothly.
Standard
Clockwise
Couterclockwise
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Motor gear rotates clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
B127536E02
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (MASTER SWITCH - SWITCH)
WS
WS–30
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Rear LH Only
DESCRIPTION
If the manual UP/DOWN function does not operate, the power window motor, the power window switch or
the wire harness is abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
P14
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Rear LH)
P10
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly Rear (Rear LH)
WS
2
L-B
1
D
1
L
3
U
4
B
2
SD
5
SU
W
From Power Window Relay
To Power Window Master Switch (Ground)
To Power Window Master Switch (Ground)
B062900E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
P10
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly
Rear (Rear LH)
(a) Disconnect the P38 regulator switch connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the voltage between the terminal 4 of the wire
harness side connector and the body ground.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
NG
B062901E08
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (SWITCH - RELAY)
WS–31
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
2
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH (REAR LH)
(a) Remove the regulator switch.
(b) Check the resistance between the switch terminals when
the switch is operated, as shown in the table below.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
Regulator Switch
1 - 2, 3 - 4
UP
1 - 2, 3 - 5
OFF
1 - 4, 3- 5
DOWN
Specified Condition
Continuity
B063163E12
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR (REAR LH)
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - MOTOR) (SWITCH - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P14 motor connector.
(b) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
P10
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assembly Rear (Rear LH)
Terminal No.
P10-3 - P14-1
P10-1 - P14-2
Specified Condition
Continuity
(c) Check the resistance between the P10 regulator switch
connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
P14
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly LH (Rear LH)
P10-1 - Body ground
P10-3 - Body ground
NG
B063164E07
OK
Specified Condition
No continuity
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
WS
WS–32
4
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH (REAR LH)
(a) Remove the motor.
(b) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and 2.
(c) Check that the motor smoothly rotates.
Standard
Motor Gear
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
WS
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Motor gear rotates clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
B127535E01
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH (REAR LH)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (MASTER SWITCH - SWITCH)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–33
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Rear RH Only
DESCRIPTION
If the manual UP/DOWN function does not operate, the power window motor, the regulator switch or the
wire harness may be malfunctioning.
WIRING DIAGRAM
P15
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly RH (Rear RH)
P11
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly Rear (Rear RH)
WS
2
L-B
1
D
1
L
3
U
4
B
2
SD
5
SU
W
From Power Window Relay
To Power Window Master Switch (Ground)
To Power Window Master Switch (Ground)
B062900E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
P11
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly
Rear (Rear RH)
(a) Disconnect the P11 regulator switch connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Check the voltage between the terminal 4 of the wire
harness side connector and the body ground.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
NG
B062901E09
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (SWITCH - RELAY)
WS–34
2
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH (REAR RH)
(a) Remove the regulator switch.
(b) Check the resistance between the switch terminals when
the switch is operated, as shown in the table below.
Standard resistance
WS
Terminal No.
Regulator Switch
1 - 2, 3 - 4
UP
1 - 2, 4 - 5
OFF
1 - 4, 3- 5
DOWN
Specified Condition
Continuity
B063163E12
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH (REAR RH)
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - MOTOR) (SWITCH - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P15 motor connector.
(b) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side:
P11
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assembly Rear (Rear RH)
Terminal No.
P11-3 - P15-1
P11-1 - P15-2
Specified Condition
Continuity
(c) Check the resistance between the P9 regulator switch
connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
Terminal No.
P15
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assembly RH (Rear RH)
P11-1) - Body ground
P11-3) - Body ground
NG
B063164E08
OK
Specified Condition
No continuity
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
4
WS–35
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY RH (REAR RH)
Motor Gear
(a) Remove the motor.
(b) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and 2.
(c) Check that the motor smoothly rotates.
Standard
Clockwise
Couterclockwise
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Motor gear rotates clockwise
B127536E02
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY RH (REAR RH)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASTER SWITCH - SWITCH)
WS
MI–7
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AUTOMATIC GLARE-RESISTANT EC MIRROR
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Fuse
Auto glare-resistant EC mirror does not operate
See page
-
2. Inner rear view mirror
MI-8
3. Wire harness
-
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
Cover
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR (w/o
Electronic Mirror)
(a) Pushing portions (a) as indicated in the illustration,
remove the cover.
(b) Pushing the claw in the direction (b), slide the mirror
assembly in the direction (c) to remove it.
(a)
Claw
(b)
(c)
B064964E08
2.
Slide
B064963E01
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR (w/ Electronic
Mirror)
(a) Disconnect the mirror cover.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the mirror assembly as shown in the
illustration.
MI
MI–8
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
INSPECTION
1.
1
2
MI
Black Colored Tape
Forward Sensor
B057086E01
INSPECT INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect operation of the electrochromic inner mirror.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to
terminal 2.
(2) Attach black colored tape to the forward sensor
to prevent it from sensing.
(3) Light up the mirror with an electric light, and
check that the mirror surface changes from
bright to dark.
Standard:
Mirror surface changes from bright to dark
If the result is not as specified, replace the
mirror assembly.
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MI–9
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR (w/ Electronic
Mirror)
2.
INSTALL INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR (w/o
Electronic Mirror)
MI
MI–11
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the front door lower frame bracket garnish
LH.
(b) Remove the front door inside handle bezel LH.
(c) Remove the front armrest assembly LH.
(d) Remove the front door trim board LH.
(e) Remove the front door service cover LH.
2.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and mirror.
MI
B062419E01
INSPECTION
1.
(A)
(C)
(D)
(B)
B062851E01
INSPECT OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the mirror connector.
(b) Apply battery voltage and check operation of the
mirror face, as shown in the table and illustration.
Standard
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 3
(MV)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Turns upward (A)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 3
(MV)
Turns downward (B)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
(MH)
Turns right (C)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
(MH)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Turns left (D)
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror
assembly.
MI–12
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
2.
(A)
(C)
(B)
(D)
MI
B062850E01
INSPECT OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Inspect outer mirror motor operation.
(b) Apply battery voltage and check operation of the
mirror face, as shown in the table and illustration.
Standard
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 3
(MV)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Turns upward (A)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 3
(MV)
Turns downward (B)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
(MH)
Turns right (C)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
(MH)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
(M+)
Turns left (D)
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror
assembly.
INSTALLATION
1.
B062419E02
INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the mirror with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
MIRROR – POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
MI–1
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
MIRROR
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
OUTER MIRROR SWITCH
MI
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
B142022E01
MI–2
MIRROR – POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Mirror does not operate
Suspected area
MI-13
2. Outer rear view mirror assembly
MI-11
3. Wire harness
Mirror operate abnormally
-
1. Outer mirror switch assembly
MI-13
2. Outer rear view mirror assembly
MI-11
3. Wire harness
MI
See page
1. Outer mirror switch assembly
-
MI–3
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MIRROR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
MI
RH VISOR ASSEMBLY
ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
LH VISOR ASSEMBLY
VISOR HOLDER
RH VISOR
VISOR HOLDER
LH VISOR
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
W/ ELECTRO CHROMIC MIRROR:
MIRROR COVER
INNER REAR VIEW
MIRROR
B120220E04
MI–4
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
CALIBRATION
1.
2.
MI
3.
4.
SELECT COMPASS DISPLAY MODE
(a) The COMP switch allows you to select the Display
or Non-display mode of the compass.
SET ZONE
(a) Deviation between the "magnetic north" and "actual
north" differs depending on the location. Therefore,
adjustment of the magnetism is required. Since the
magnetic condition differs depending on the area
where the vehicle is used, it is necessary for each
user to set the zone (Refer to Compass Zone Map).
The zone setting can be changed using the COMP
switch of the inner mirror.
PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Because each vehicle has its own magnetic field,
calibration should be performed for each vehicle.
This compass function is used when storing the
record of the vehicle's magnetic field.
WHEN COMPASS IS MAGNETIZED
(a) A compass could be magnetized during shipping by
vessels or freight cars. Therefore, make sure to
perform calibration and ensure that calibration is
performed properly before delivery. If it cannot be
done (cannot be completed in spite of driving
around several times), it may be caused by
magnetization. Demagnetize the vehicle using a
demagnetizer and perform calibration again.
MI–5
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
5.
COMP Switch
SET COMPASS
On Duration
Normal
Ignition Switch ON
Pressed
Compass Non-display Mode
Pressed for 3 sec.
Zone Setting Mode (Step 6)
Pressed for 6 sec.
MI
COMP Switch ON
Zone area +1
Calibration (Step 7)
Leaving it untouched
for a while
Normal Mode
B111243E01
6.
7.
ZONE SETTING MODE
(a) Pressing the COMP switch for 3 seconds in the
normal mode will activate the zone setting mode. A
number (1 to 15) is displayed on the compass
display.
NOTICE:
In the initial state, "8" is displayed.
(b) The displayed number increases by 1 every time the
COMP switch is pressed. Referring to the map,
check the number for the area where the vehicle will
be used and set the zone number.
(c) Leave it untouched for several seconds after setting
and check that the compass display shows an
azimuthal direction (N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W or NW)
or "C".
CALIBRATION SETTING MODE
(a) Pressing the COMP switch for 6 seconds in the
normal mode will activate the calibration setting
mode.
MI–6
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
(b) Drive the vehicle at a slow speed of 8 km/h (5 mph)
or less in the circular direction.
(c) Driving around the circle 1 to 3 times will display the
azimuthal direction on the display, completing the
calibration.
NOTICE:
After the calibration is completed, it is not
necessary to perform the above procedures
unless the magnetic field strength is drastically
changed. If this happens, the azimuthal display
will be changed to "C".
Zone Setting Map:
MI
B057087E01
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MI–9
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MIRROR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR SERVICE
HOLE COVER LH
MI
FRONT ARMREST
ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE BEZEL LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT DOOR TRIM
BOARD LH
Non-reusable part
B120197E04
MI–10
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MI
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
ASSEMBLY LH
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
ASSEMBLY RH
B134259E04
MI–13
MIRROR – OUTER MIRROR SWITCH
OUTER MIRROR SWITCH
LEFT
RIGHT
INSPECTION
Left/Right Adjustment Switch
1.
Mirror
Switch
UP
LEFT
OFF
INSPECT OUTER MIRROR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the outer mirror switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below when the switch is
operated.
Resistance:
Select "L" on the left/right adjustment
switch
Tester Connection
RIGHT
4-8
No Pin
No Pin
4-7
MI
DOWN
6-8
Below 1 Ω
5-8
LEFT
6-7
B059702E10
Specified Condition
UP
6-7
DOWN
Switch Position
5-7
RIGHT
6-8
Select "R" on the left/right adjustment
switch
Tester Connection
3-8
6-7
3-7
6-8
2-8
6-7
2-7
6-8
Switch Position
Specified Condition
UP
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
LEFT
RIGHT
IP–6
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
REMOVAL
1.
BOLT, SCREW AND NUT TABLE
HINT:
The bolts, screws and nuts, which are necessary for
installation and removal of the instrument panel are
shown in the illustration below and the text with
alphabets.
mm (in.) (L = Length)
Code
Shape
Code
φ=8
(0.31)
L = 24
(0.94)
Shape
Code
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 18
(0.71)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 14
(0.55)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 18.5
(0.73)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 18
(0.71)
φ=6
(0.24)
IP
Shape
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 14
(0.55)
B065712E01
B062737
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
HINT:
RS-1
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
(a) Remove the instrument panel finish plate.
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
4 Clips
IP–7
4.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts .
(b) Disconnect the hood lock control cable assembly
and fuel lid lock control cable sub-assembly.
(c) Disengage the 4 clips.
(d) Disconnect the connectors and remove the lower
instrument panel finish panel sub-assembly.
5.
REMOVE CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 5 clips and 2 claws, and remove the
console upper rear panel, and then disconnect the
connectors.
B062738E01
IP
2 Claws
5 Clips
2 Claws
6 Clips
Clip
B062740E01
6.
REMOVE UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 6 clips and 2 claws, and then remove
the upper console panel sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to snap the claws during the
operation.
7.
REMOVE NO. 1 CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH
(a) Disengage the clip.
(b) Pull the No. 1 console upper panel garnish rearward
to be removed.
8.
REMOVE NO. 2 CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH
9.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw.
B062741E01
B062742E01
B062744
IP–8
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(b) Disengage the 4 clips and remove the air
conditioner, and then disconnect the connectors.
4 Clips
B062757E01
10. REMOVE CENTER INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts .
(b) Disengage the 8 clips and remove the center
instrument cluster finish panel sub-assembly.
IP
11. REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY (w/ Bracket)
(See page AV-167)
12. REMOVE NO. 2 LOWER STEERING WHEEL COVER
8 Clips
B062745E01
13. REMOVE NO. 3 LOWER STEERING WHEEL COVER
14. REMOVE STEERING PAD (See page RS-388)
15. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-9)
16. REMOVE UPR STEERING COLUMN COVER
17. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (w/
Bracket) (See page SR-10)
18. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts .
(b) Disengage the 2 claws and remove the instrument
panel lower LH.
2 Claws
B062739E01
19. REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 7 clips.
(b) Disconnect the connectors and remove the
instrument cluster finish panel sub-assembly.
20. REMOVE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (See
page ME-60)
7 Clips
B062746E01
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
21. REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and rear console box
assembly.
IP–9
22. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-9)
B078371E01
23. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Disengage the 2 claws and remove the cowl side
trim board RH.
IP
2 Claws
B062748E01
24. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw .
(b) Disengage the 3 clips and remove the No. 2
instrument panel under cover sub-assembly.
3 Clips
B062749E01
25. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw and glove compartment
door.
(b) Deform the upper part of the glove compartment
door to release the stoppers.
(c) Pull the glove compartment door upward to remove
it.
2 Claws
2 Clips
B062750E01
26. DISCONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
(See page RS-403)
27. REMOVE NO. 2 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL
(a) Remove the 4 screws .
(b) Disengage the 2 claws and remove the instrument
panel finish panel.
2 Claws
B062751E01
IP–10
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
28. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw .
(b) Disengage the 2 clips and 2 claws, and then remove
the No. 2 instrument panel register assembly.
29. REMOVE ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY
2 Claws
2 Clips
B062752E01
Clip B
IP
Clip A
Claw
Claw
B063600E04
30. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 assist grip plugs.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw. Remove
the clip labeled A, clip labeled B and pillar garnish.
31. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
IP–11
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
32. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 9 bolts and nut .
IP
B120219E01
(b) Disconnect the connectors.
(c) Remove the instrument panel safety pad subassembly.
33. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a moulding remover, disengage the 4 clips
and remove the No. 1 instrument panel speaker
panel sub-assembly.
34. REMOVE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and the front stereo
component speaker assembly.
IP–12
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
35. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL PIN
(a) Remove the screw and the No. 1 instrument
panel pin.
36. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and the defroster nozzle
assembly.
37. REMOVE NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
(a) Remove the 5 screws and the No. 2 heater to
register duct.
38. REMOVE NO. 1 METER HOOD RETAINER
(a) Remove the screw and the No. 1 meter hood
retainer.
IP
39. REMOVE CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw and the center instrument
panel bracket sub-assembly.
40. REMOVE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the automatic light control sensor.
41. REMOVE COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
42. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
43. REMOVE ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page AV-181)
44. REMOVE NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY (w/
Navigation System) (See page NS-239)
45. REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
GARNISH
(a) Remove the 3 screws and the instrument
cluster finish panel garnish.
46. REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(See page RS-403)
47. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–13
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
GARNISH
4.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY (w/
Navigation System)
5.
INSTALL ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
7.
INSTALL COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
8.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
9.
INSTALL CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY
10. INSTALL NO. 1 METER HOOD RETAINER
11. INSTALL NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
12. INSTALL DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
13. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL PIN
14. INSTALL FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
15. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
16. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using a torque wrench, install the bolt .
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
IP
IP–14
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP
B120219E02
17. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
18. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
19. INSTALL ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY
20. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
21. INSTALL NO. 2 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL
22. CONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
23. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
24. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–15
25. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
26. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
27. INSTALL REAR CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
28. INSTALL COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
29. INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
30. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
31. INSTALL TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY (w/
Bracket)
32. INSTALL UPPER STEERING COLUMN COVER
33. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
34. INSTALL STEERING PAD
35. INSTALL NO. 3 LOWER STEERING WHEEL COVER
36. INSTALL NO. 2 LOWER STEERING WHEEL COVER
37. INSTALL RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY (w/ Bracket)
38. INSTALL CENTER INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
39. INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
40. INSTALL NO. 2 CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH
41. INSTALL NO. 1 CONSOLE UPPER PANEL GARNISH
42. INSTALL UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
43. INSTALL CONSOLE UPPER REAR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
44. INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
45. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PLATE
46. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
IP
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–1
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY
PAD
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION FOR VEHICLE WITH SRS AIRBAG
AND SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(a) Some operations in this section may affect the SRS
airbag. Prior to performing the corresponding
operations, read the SRS airbag NOTICE (See
page RS-1).
IP
IP–2
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
COMPONENTS
RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
WITH BRACKET
IP
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
FINISH PANEL GARNISH
CENTER INSTRUMENT
CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL LOWER LH
B120190E04
IP–3
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
NO. 1 CONSOLE UPPER
PANEL GARNISH
NO. 2 CONSOLE UPPER
PANEL GARNISH
INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PLATE
CONSOLE UPPER REAR
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
UPPER CONSOLE PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WITH BRACKET
UPPER STEERING COLUMN COVER
REAR CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 LOWER STEERING
WHEEL COVER
NO. 2 LOWER STEERING
WHEEL COVER
STEERING PAD
B120191E06
IP
IP–4
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
ASSIST GRIP
SUB-ASSEMBLY
ASSIST GRIP
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
20 (204, 15)
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY
PAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
IP
C
A A
C
C
C
C
B
H
G
C
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
NO. 2 LOWER INSTRUMENT
PANEL FINISH PANEL
E
E E
E
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
GLOVE COMPARTMENT
DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
F
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
E
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120192E03
IP–5
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
DEFROSTER NOZZLE
ASSEMBLY
WITH AUDIO PREMIUM VERSION:
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
SPEAKER PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
IP
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
WITH LIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM:
COOLER (SOLAR
SENSOR)
THERMISTOR
AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL SENSOR
NO. 1
INSTRUMENT
PANEL PIN
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL PIN
WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM:
CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 METER
HOOD RETAINER
B120193E03
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
SE–9
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• Always wear gloves because the sharp edges of the
seatback frame and seat adjuster may cause injury.
• Work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the LOCK position and the
negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the
battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source. If
work is started within 90 seconds after disconnecting
the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS
may deploy.)
HINT:
• Installation is in the reverse order of removal. However,
only installation procedures requiring additional
information are included.
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (See page SS-1).
• COMPONENTS: See page SE-6
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the seat track bracket
cover outer front LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the seat track bracket cover inner
front LH is the same as for the seat track bracket cover
outer front LH.
4.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the seat track outer cover LH is
the same as for the seat track bracket cover outer front
LH.
5.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the seat track bracket cover inner
LH is the same as for the seat track bracket cover outer
front LH.
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connectors under the front seat
assembly LH.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and front seat assembly LH.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
SE
SE–10
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
DISASSEMBLY
Claw
1.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB LH
(a) Using a cloth etc., remove the snap ring and vertical
seat adjuster knob LH.
3.
REMOVE VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB CAP
(a) Using a scraper, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the vertical seat adjuster knob cap.
HINT:
Tape the scraper tip before use.
4.
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTING HANDLE NO. 2
(a) Remove the 2 screws and vertical adjusting handle
No. 2.
5.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE
HANDLE LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the reclining adjuster
release handle LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Driver seat only:
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws
and clip, and remove the front seat cushion
shield LH, and then disconnect the connector.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Passenger seat only:
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws
and clip, and remove the front seat cushion
shield LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and power seat switch
assembly.
8.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
B089215E01
SE
B089216
Claw
Clip
B065148E01
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
9.
Claw
Clip
B065149E01
SE–11
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and clip,
and remove the front seat cushion shield inner LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
10. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER WITH PAD
(a) Disengage the hook and remove the seat cushion
cover together with the pad.
11. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER
(a) Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover.
12. REMOVE FRONT SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
(a) Remove the 2 front seat headrest supports.
SE
B060977
13. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE SEATBACK COVER
WITH PAD
(a) with Side airbag:
(1) Remove the hog rings, nut and seatback cover
bracket.
(b) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together
with the pad.
B065179
14. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Remove the hog rings and front seatback cover.
15. REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH
(a) Remove the screw and reclining adjuster inside
cover LH (lower).
(b) Remove the screw and reclining adjuster inside
cover LH (upper).
16. REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH
(a) Remove the screw and reclining adjuster inside
cover RH (lower).
(b) Remove the screw and reclining adjuster inside
cover RH (upper).
17. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER
LH
(a) Remove the front seat cushion shield lower LH.
18. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER
RH
(a) Remove the front seat cushion shield lower RH.
SE–12
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
19. REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER BUSH
20. REMOVE LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and lumbar support adjuster
assembly LH.
21. REMOVE SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
22. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION PROTECTOR
23. REMOVE SEAT WIRE NO. 2
(a) Remove the wiring harness connectors.
24. REMOVE OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU
HINT:
See page RS-447
SE
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
SE–13
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU
HINT:
See page RS-447
2.
INSTALL SEAT WIRE NO. 2
3.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION PROTECTOR
4.
INSTALL SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
HINT:
See page RS-444
5.
INSTALL LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY LH
6.
INSTALL VERTICAL ADJUSTER BUSH
7.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER
RH
8.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER LH
9.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH
10. INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH
11. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Install the seatback pad.
(b) Cover the top of the seatback pad with the front
seatback cover.
Hog Ring Pliers
B050126E17
(c) Using hog ring pliers, install the front seatback cover
to the seatback pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, take care to
prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
12. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER WITH PAD
(a) Install the seatback cover together with the pad with
new hog rings.
(b) with Side airbag:
(1) Install the front seatback cover bracket with the
nut.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
B065179
SE
SE–14
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
(c) with Side airbag:
(1) Install the wire harness and clamp of the side
airbag through the seat cushion cover end.
(d) Using hog ring pliers, install new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
Clamp
13. INSTALL FRONT SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
B065611E01
Hog Ring Pliers
SE
14. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER
(a) Install the front seat cushion pad to the seat cushion
cover.
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the seat cushion cover
to the seat cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, take care to
prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
15. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER WITH PAD
B050126E17
16. INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER LH
17. INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
18. INSTALL POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
19. INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
20. INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE HANDLE
LH
21. INSTALL VERTICAL ADJUSTING HANDLE NO. 2
22. INSTALL VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB CAP
23. INSTALL VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB LH
24. INSTALL FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
SE–15
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Place the front seat assembly LH in the cabin.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
(b) Connect the connectors under the front seat
assembly LH.
(c) Install the front seat assembly LH with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
3.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
4.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH
5.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH
6.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
7.
CHECK SEAT SLIDE ADJUSTER LOCKS
(a) When sliding the front seat assembly LH, check that
both sides of the adjuster lock simultaneously.
SE
SE–42
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the headrest.
(b) Tumble the seat.
(c) Disengage the claws and remove the rear seat
cushion hinge covers No. 2 LH and RH.
(d) Set the rear seat to the floor.
Claw
B078863E01
(e) Disengage the claws and remove the rear seat
cushion hinge covers No .3 LH and RH.
(f) Tumble the seat.
(g) Remove the 3 bolts, nut and seat.
SE
Claw
B064886E01
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
SE–43
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the screw cover, screw
and release handle LH.
(b) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
reclining cover LH.
A
Claw
A
B
B
B
B063206E01
A
A
Claw
B
(c) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
reclining cover RH.
B
C
B
C
C
B063202E01
(d) Disengage the seatback cover hem.
B063210
B063212
(e) Insert a screwdriver between the seat cushion cover
and seat cushion under cover.
NOTICE:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(f) Pry the seat cushion cover hem to disengage it.
(g) Cut the hog rings and bring out the seat cushion
cover together with the pad.
(h) Remove the nut and disconnect the rear seat 3point type seat belt assembly LH.
(i) Remove the seat cushion cover together with the
pad.
(j) Cut the hog rings and remove the seat cushion
cover from the pad.
SE
SE–44
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Open the faster of the seatback cover.
(b) Remove the screw and armrest cover.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts, guide, armrest hinge and
armrest.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the seat lock control cables from the
seatback frame.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts, washer, grommet and seatback
stopper plate.
(c) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
2 reclining covers.
(d) Remove the 4 bolts and rear seatback LH.
4.
SE
Claw
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER LH
(a) Remove the 2 tether anchor covers.
(b) Remove the rear seat protector.
B064887E01
(c) Push the claws and remove the 4 headrest
supports.
(d) Remove the rear seat shoulder belt hole cover.
(e) Remove the seatback cover together with the pad.
(f) Cut the rings and remove the seatback cover.
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and reclining adjuster cover.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the rear seat shoulder
belt hole cover.
(c) Remove the 2 nuts, 2 screws and seat belt.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using the screwdriver, remove the spring of the seat
stay ball-joint.
(b) Disconnect the ball-joint from the seat cushion
frame.
(c) Remove the hinge cover, E-ring, pin, hinge guide,
spring and hinge together with the seat stay.
7.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the hinge cover, E-ring, pin, hinge guide
and hinge.
8.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER LH
(a) Remove the 7 screws, cushion and cover.
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and rear seat belt inner.
(b) Remove the nut and rear seat belt inner No. 2.
B060977
B064869
10. REMOVE FOLD SEAT LOCK CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
SE–45
11. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT LOCK CABLE
ASSEMBLY
12. REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL WIRE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
SE
SE–46
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FOLD SEAT LOCK CONTROL CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear seat belt inner No. 2 with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the rear seat belt inner with the nut.
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER LH
(a) Install the cover with the 6 screws.
(b) Install the cushion with the screw.
4.
INSTALL REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the hinge guide to the hinge.
(b) Install the hinge with the pin and new E-ring.
(c) Install the hinge cover.
5.
INSTALL REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the spring to the ball-joint of the seat stay.
(b) Connect the ball-joint to the seat cushion frame
securely.
(c) Install the spring and hinge guide to the hinge.
(d) Install the hinge with the pin and new E-ring.
(e) Install the hinge cover.
6.
INSTALL NO. 1 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the seat belt with the 2 nuts and 2 screws.
(b) Install the rear seat shoulder belt hole cover.
(c) Install the reclining adjuster cover with the 2 screws.
7.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK COVER LH
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad with
new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover together with the pad to
the seatback frame.
(c) Install the 2 headrest supports.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to mistake the headrest support
direction.
(d) Connect the rear seat lock cable to the rear seat
reclining cover.
(e) Install the rear seat protector.
(f) Install the 2 tether anchor covers.
8.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the rear seatback LH with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
SE
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
SE–47
(b) Install the 2 reclining covers with the 2 screws.
(c) Install the seatback stopper plate to the seat
cushion frame with the 2 bolts.
(d) Install the grommet, washer and bolt.
(e) Connect the seat lock control cables to the seatback
frame.
9.
Claw
B064887E01
INSTALL REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Install the armrest.
(b) Install the guide to the armrest hinge.
(c) Install the armrest hinge with the 3 bolts.
(d) Install the armrest cover with the screw.
(e) Close the faster of the seatback cover.
10. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER LH
(a) Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion
pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the No .1 seat 3-point type belt through the
seat cushion pad.
(c) Install the No .1 seat 3-point type belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the seat cushion cover together with the pad
to the seat cushion frame with new hog rings.
(e) Securely engage the seat cushion cover hem to the
seat cushion under cover.
B063212
(f)
B063210
Engage the seatback cover hem.
SE
SE–48
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
(g) Install the reclining cover RH with the 2 screws.
A
A
Claw
B
B
B
C
C
C
B063202E01
A
B
B
Claw
A
B
SE
B063206E01
(h) Install the reclining cover LH with the 2 screws.
(i) Install the release handle LH with the screw.
(j) Install the screw cover.
SE–1
SEAT – FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
SEAT
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
LUMBER SUPPORT MOTOR
RECLINING MOTOR
RECLINING MOTOR
SE
FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH RH
SLIDE MOTOR
SLIDE MOTOR
FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH LH
REAR VERTICAL MOTOR
FRONT VERTICAL MOTOR
POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(LUMBER SUPPORT)
B120224E02
SE–2
SEAT – FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM:
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Front power seat switch
Power seat does not operate
Only slide operation function does not operate
-
3. Wire harness
-
1. Front power seat switch
SE-54
2. Slide motor
SE-56
SE-54
2. Front vertical motor
SE-56
Only reclining operation function does not operate
SE-54
2. Lifter motor
SE-56
-
1. Front power seat switch
SE-54
2. Reclining motor
SE-56
3. Wire harness
Only lumbar support operation function does not
operate (Driver seat only)
-
1. Front power seat switch
3. Wire harness
SE
-
1. Front power seat switch
3. Wire harness
Only Rear vertical operation function does not operate
(Driver seat only)
SE-54
2. PWR SEAT fuse
3. Wire harness
Only front vertical operation function does not operate
(Driver seat only)
See page
-
1. Power seat switch assembly (Lumbar support)
SE-58
2. Lumbar support adjuster motor
SE-59
3. Wire harness
-
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK POWER SEAT FUNCTION
(a) Check the basic functions.
(1) Operate the power seat switches and check the
following seat functions:
• Sliding
• Reclining
• Front vertical (Driver side seat only)
• Lifter (Driver side seat only)
• Lumbar support (Driver side seat only)
2.
CHECK POWER SEAT MOTOR ASSEMBLY (SLIDING,
FRONT VERTICAL, LIFTER AND RECLINING
FUNCTION)
(a) Inspect the PTC operation inside the power seat
motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the
seat installed in the vehicle.
(1) Move the seat to any of the maximum position
by operating the power seat switch, and keep
the seat there for approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Try to move the power seat beyond the
maximum position using the power seat switch.
Measure the time needed for shutting off the
electrical current after the lumbar support stops
moving. (motor operation sound will stop,
inspection of current shut-off).
Standard:
4 to 90 seconds
Reclining Function
Lumbar Support
Function
Front Vertical
Function
Lifter Function
Sliding Function
B076688E01
SEAT – FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
SE–3
(3) Release the power seat switch, and wait for
approximately 60 seconds.
(4) Operate the power seat switch to move the
seat to the opposite position and check that the
motor operates.
3.
CHECK LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the PTC operation inside the power seat
motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the
seat installed in the vehicle.
(1) Move the lumbar support to either the foremost
or rearmost position by operating the lumbar
support switch, and keep it there for
approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Try to move the lumbar support beyond the
maximum position using the switch. Measure
the time needed for shutting off the electrical
current after the lumbar support stops moving.
(motor operation sound will stop, inspection of
current shut-off).
Standard:
4 to 90 seconds
(3) Release the lumbar support switch, and wait for
approximately 60 seconds.
(4) Operate the lumbar support switch to move the
lumbar support to the opposite position and
check that the motor operates.
SE
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
SE–49
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the seat with the 3 bolts and nut.
Torque: 37 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(b) Set the rear seat to the floor.
(c) Install the rear sat cushion hinge covers No. 2 LH
and RH.
(d) Tumble the seat.
Claw
B064886E01
(e) Install the rear seat cushion hinge covers No. 2 LH
and RH.
(f) Install the headrest.
Claw
B078863E01
SE
SE–50
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the headrest.
(b) Tumble the seat.
(c) Disengage the claws and remove the rear seat
cushion hinge covers No. 2 LH and RH.
(d) Set the rear seat to the floor.
Claw
B078863E01
(e) Disengage the claws and remove the rear seat
cushion hinge covers No. 3 LH and RH.
(f) Tumble the seat.
(g) Remove the 3 bolts, nut and seat.
SE
Claw
B064886E01
DISASSEMBLY
A
B
Claw
A
B
C
B
C
C
1.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER RH
(a) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
reclining cover LH.
(b) Using a screwdriver and remove the screw cover,
screw and release handle RH.
B063201E01
(c) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
reclining cover RH.
Claw
A
A
B
B
B
B063205E01
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
SE–51
(d) Disengage the seatback cover hem.
(e) Remove the tether anchor cover.
(f) Open the fastener of the seatback cover and
remove the rear seat protector.
B063209
(g) Push the claws and remove the 2 headrest
supports.
(h) Remove the seatback cover together with the pad.
(i) Cut the hog rings and remove the seatback cover.
SE
B060977
2.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER RH
(a) Insert a screwdriver between the seat cushion cover
and seat cushion under cover.
NOTICE:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pry the seat cushion cover hem to disengage it.
(c) Cut the hog rings and remove the seat cushion
cover together with the pad.
(d) Cut the hog rings and remove the seat cushion
cover.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the hinge cover, E-ring, pin, hinge guide
and hinge.
4.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the spring of the seat
stay ball-joint.
(b) Disconnect the ball-joint from the seat cushion
frame.
(c) Remove the hinge cover, E-ring, pin, hinge guide,
spring and hinge together with the seat stay.
5.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER RH
(a) Remove the 4 screws and cover.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and belt.
7.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT LOCK CABLE
ASSEMBLY
8.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT LOCK CONTROL CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
B063211
B064868
SE–52
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REMOVE SEAT LOCK CONTROL CABLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT LOCK CABLE
ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and belt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER LH
(a) Remove the 4 screws and cover.
5.
INSTALL REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the spring to the ball-joint of the seat stay.
(b) Connect the ball-joint to the seat cushion frame
securely.
(c) Install the spring and hinge guide to the hinge.
(d) Install the hinge with the pin and new E-ring.
(e) Install the hinge cover.
6.
INSTALL REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the hinge guide to the hinge.
(b) Install the hinge with the pin and new E-ring.
(c) Install the hinge cover.
7.
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER RH
(a) Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion
pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover together with the pad
to the seat cushion frame with new hog rings.
SE
(c) Engage the seat cushion cover hem to the seat
cushion under cover securely.
8.
B063211
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER RH
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad with
new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover together with the pad to
the seatback frame.
(c) Install the 2 headrest supports.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to mistake the headrest support
direction.
(d) Install the rear seat protector and close the fastener
of the seatback cover.
(e) Install the tether anchor cover.
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
(f)
SE–53
Engage the seatback cover hem.
B063209
Claw
(g) Install the reclining cover RH with the 2 screws.
(h) Install the release handle RH with the screw.
(i) Install the screw cover.
A
A
B
B
B
SE
B063205E01
(j)
A
B
C
Claw
A
B
C
B
C
B063201E01
Install the reclining cover LH with the 2 screws.
SE–54
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the seat with the 3 bolts and nut.
Torque: 37 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(b) Set the rear seat to the floor.
(c) Install the rear seat cushion hinge covers No. 3 LH
and RH.
(d) Tumble the seat.
Claw
B064886E01
SE
(e) Install the rear seat cushion hinge covers No. 2 LH
and RH.
(f) Install the headrest.
Claw
B078863E01
SE–18
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
REMOVAL
SE
CAUTION:
• Always wear gloves because the sharp edges of the
seatback frame and seat adjuster may cause injury.
• Work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the LOCK position and the
negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the
battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source. If
work is started within 90 seconds from disconnecting
the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS
may be deployed.)
HINT:
• Installation is in the reverse order of removal. However,
only installation procedures requiring additional
information are included.
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (See page SS-2).
• COMPONENTS: See page SE-15
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the seat track bracket
cover outer front LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER RH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the seat track bracket cover inner
front LH is the same as for the seat track bracket cover
outer front LH.
4.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the seat track outer cover RH is
the same as for the seat track bracket cover outer front
LH.
5.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the seat track bracket cover inner
LH is the same as for the seat track bracket cover outer
front LH.
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connectors under the front seat
assembly LH.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and front seat assembly LH.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
SE–19
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE RECLINING POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the reclining power
seat switch knob.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE SLIDE & VERTICAL POWER SEAT SWITCH
KNOB
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the slide & vertical
power seat switch knob.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER
NO. 1 LH
(a) Remove the 5 screws.
(b) Driver seat only:
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws
and remove the front seat cushion shield inner
No. 1 LH with the front seat cushion shield LH,
and then disconnect the connector.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Passenger seat only:
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws
and remove the front seat cushion shield inner
No. 1 LH with the front seat cushion shield LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(d) Remove the screw and front seat cushion shield
inner No. 1 LH.
Claw
B065797E01
Claw
Clip
5.
REMOVE POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and power seat switch
assembly.
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
7.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and clip,
and remove the front seat cushion shield inner LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH LH
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and front power seat switch
LH.
9.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER WITH PAD
(a) Disengage the hook and remove the seat cushion
cover together with the pad.
B065449E01
SE
SE–20
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
10. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER
(a) Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover.
11. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER
ASSEMBLY LH
12. REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and front seatback board.
13. REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD COVER SUBASSEMBLY
14. REMOVE FRONT SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
(a) Remove the 2 front seat headrest supports.
SE
B060977
15. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE SEATBACK COVER
WITH PAD
(a) with Side airbag:
(1) Remove the hog rings, nut and seatback cover
bracket.
(b) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together
with the pad.
B065179
16. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Remove the hog rings and front seatback cover.
17. REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK HEATER ASSEMBLY
LH
18. REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and reclining adjuster inside
cover LH (lower).
(b) Remove the screw and reclining adjuster inside
cover LH (upper).
19. REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and reclining adjuster inside
cover RH (lower).
(b) Remove the screw and reclining adjuster inside
cover RH (upper).
20. REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER
OUTER
(a) Remove the screw and vertical adjuster bracket
cover outer.
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
SE–21
21. REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER
INNER
(a) Remove the screw and vertical adjuster bracket
cover inner.
22. REMOVE LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and lumbar support adjuster
assembly LH.
23. REMOVE SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
HINT:
See page RS-443
24. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION PROTECTOR
25. REMOVE SEAT WIRE NO. 2
26. REMOVE OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU
HINT:
See page RS-447
SE
SE–4
SEAT – SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
SEAT
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT SEATBACK HEATER ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEATBACK HEATER ASSEMBLY LH
SE
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
HEATER ASSEMBLY RH
SEAT HEATER SWITCH RH
SEAT HEATER SWITCH LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER ASSEMBLY LH
B120225E01
SE–5
SEAT – SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM:
Symptom
Suspected area
1. SEAT HEATER fuse
Seat heaters do not operate (Seat is not warmed up)
-
2. IG1 fuse
-
3. IG relay
-
4. Front seat cushion heater assembly LH
SE-63
5. Front seat cushion heater assembly RH
SE-63
6. Front seatback heater assembly LH
SE-62
7. Front seatback heater assembly RH
SE-62
8. Seat heater switch LH
SE-60
9. Seat heater switch RH
SE-60
10.Wire harness
Temperature of seat heater cannot be adjusted
See page
-
1. Seat heater switch LH
SE-60
2. Seat heater switch RH
SE-60
3. Wire harness
-
SE
SE–22
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
REASSEMBLY
SE
1.
INSTALL OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU
HINT:
See page RS-447
2.
INSTALL SEAT WIRE NO. 2
3.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION PROTECTOR
4.
INSTALL SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
HINT:
See page RS-444
5.
INSTALL LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY LH
6.
INSTALL VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER
INNER
7.
INSTALL VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER
OUTER
8.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH
9.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH
10. REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK HEATER ASSEMBLY
LH
11. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Install the seatback pad.
(b) Cover the top of the seatback pad with the front
seatback cover.
Hog Ring Pilers
B050126E13
(c) Using hog ring pliers, install the front seatback cover
completely with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, take care to
prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
12. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER WITH PAD
(a) Install the seatback cover together with the pad with
new hog rings.
(b) with Side airbag:
(1) Install the front seatback cover bracket with the
nut.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
B065179
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
SE–23
(c) with Side airbag:
(1) Install the wire harness and clamp of the side
airbag through the seat cushion cover end.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
(d) Using hog ring pliers, install new hog rings.
Clamp
13. INSTALL FRONT SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
B065611E01
14. REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD COVER SUBASSEMBLY
15. REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD SUBASSEMBLY
16. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER
ASSEMBLY LH
17. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER
18. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER WITH PAD
(a) Install the seat cushion pad to the seat cushion
cover.
Hog Ring Pilers
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the seat cushion cover
to the seat cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, take care to
prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
19. REMOVE FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH LH
20. INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER LH
B050126E13
21. INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
HINT:
See page RS-28
22. INSTALL POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
23. INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER
NO.1 LH
24. INSTALL SLIDE & VERTICAL POWER SEAT SWITCH
KNOB
25. INSTALL RECLINING POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB
26. INSTALL FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
SE
SE–6
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
SE
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER FRONT LH
SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER FRONT LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120226E01
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
SE–7
SEAT CUSHION COVER
HOG RING
SEAT CUSHION PAD
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
DRIVER SEAT ONLY:
POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
SE
42 (428, 31)
RECLINING ADJUSTER
RELEASE HANDLE LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
SHIELD INNER LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
VERTICAL ADJUSTING HANDLE NO. 2
SNAP RING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER
VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER
KNOB LH
KNOB CAP
B120227E02
SE–8
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Manual Seat Type LH Side)
FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT
HEADREST
SUPPORT
FRONT SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
5.5 (56, 48 in.*lbf)
WITH SIDE AIRBAG:
FRONT SEATBACK PAD
HOG RING
SE
FRONT SEATBACK COVER
DRIVER SEAT ONLY:
LUMBAR SUPPORT
ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY LH
RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE
COVER RH (LOWER)
RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE
COVER RH (UPPER)
RECLINING
ADJUSTER INSIDE
COVER LH (LOWER)
RECLINING
ADJUSTER INSIDE
COVER LH (UPPER)
SEAT WIRE NO. 2
PASSENGER SEAT ONLY:
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
PROTECTOR
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
SHIELD LOWER RH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
SHIELD LOWER LH
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
ECU
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
DRIVER SEAT ONLY:
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120228E02
SE–24
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
INSTALLATION
SE
1.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Place the front seat assembly LH in the cabin.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
(b) Connect the connectors under the front seat
assembly LH.
(c) Install the front seat assembly LH with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
3.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
4.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH
5.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH
6.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
HINT:
See page RS-28
7.
CHECK SEAT SLIDE ADJUSTER LOCKS
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
SE–15
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
SE
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER FRONT LH
SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER FRONT LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120229E01
SE–16
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
HOG RING
SEAT CUSHION COVER
SEAT CUSHION PAD
WIRING HARNESS CONNECTOR
FRONT SEAT INNER
BELT ASSEMBLY LH
SE
DRIVER SEAT ONLY:
42 (428, 31)
POWER SEAT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
SHIELD INNER NO. 1 LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
SHIELD INNER LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH LH
SLIDE & VERTICAL POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
RECLINING POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB
Non-reusable part
B120230E02
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Power Seat Type LH Side)
SEPARATE TYPE FRONT
SEATBACK COVER WITH PAD
FRONT SEAT HEADREST
ASSEMBLY
SE–17
FRONT SEATBACK BOARD
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEATBACK BOARD
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT
HEADREST
SUPPORT
HOG RING
DRIVER SEAT ONLY:
5.5 (56, 48 in.*lbf)
WITH SIDE AIRBAG:
SEPARATE TYPE FRONT
SEATBACK COVER
LUMBAR SUPPORT
ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY LH
RECLINING
ADJUSTER INSIDE
COVER RH (UPPER)
RECLINING ADJUSTER
INSIDE COVER LH (UPPER)
RECLINING ADJUSTER
INSIDE COVER RH (LOWER)
FRONT SEAT CUSHION PROTECTOR
RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE
COVER LH (LOWER)
SEAT WIRE NO. 2
PASSENGER SEAT ONLY:
VERTICAL ADJUSTER
BRACKET COVER OUTER
VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER INNER
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
ECU
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
DRIVER SEAT ONLY:
Non-reusable part
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
B120231E02
SE
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–27
REMOVAL
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. However, only
installation procedures requiring additional information are
included.
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY LH
AND RH
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
CENTER
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 hinge covers.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and seat cushion.
4.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 hinge covers.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and seat cushion.
5.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 6 clips and
remove the carpet.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seatback.
7.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 9 clips and
remove the carpet.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and the floor anchor for the rear
seat belt outer center.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and seatback.
Clip
B064775E01
Clip
B064776E01
SE
SE–28
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the bolt and seatback hinge.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Remove the bolt and seatback hinge.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seatback hinge.
4.
REMOVE REAR SEAT LOCK STRIKER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and 2 lock strikers.
5.
REMOVE REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Remove the screw and armrest cover.
(b) Remove the bolt and armrest.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK COVER LH
(a) Remove the screw and seatback lock cover.
7.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK COVER RH
(a) Remove the screw and seatback lock cover.
8.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK LOCK
COVER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and
remove the stop button grommet.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 headrest supports.
(c) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together
with the pad from the seatback frame.
(d) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from the
seatback pad.
9.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK LOCK
COVER RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and
remove the stop button grommet.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
SE
B065129
B065130
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–29
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and
remove the shoulder belt cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Remove the 2 headrest supports.
(d) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together
with the pad from the seatback frame.
(e) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from the
seatback pad.
Claw
Claw
B064861E01
10. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the seatback lock release button.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and seatback lock.
11. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
12. REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER
CENTER
(a) Remove the nut and belt assembly.
13. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 hinge sub-assembly.
14. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 hinge sub-assembly.
15. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER LH
(a) Disengage the cushion cover hook.
(b) Remove the cushion cover together with the pad.
(c) Remove the 4 clips and cushion under cover.
16. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
17. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER LH
(a) Remove the hog rings and cushion cover from the
cushion pad.
18. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER RH
(a) Remove the hog rings and cushion cover from the
cushion pad.
Hog Ring Pliers
REASSEMBLY
1.
B050126E17
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER LH
(a) Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion
pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover with the pad to the
seat cushion frame with new hog rings.
HINT:
When installing hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
SE
SE–30
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
Hog Ring Pliers
SE
B050126E17
2.
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION
COVER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER LH
(a) Install the under cover with the 5 clips.
4.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER RH
(a) Install the under cover with the 7 clips.
5.
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK
COVER LH
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad RH
with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover with the pad to the
seatback frame with new hog rings.
HINT:
When installing hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
6.
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK
COVER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
7.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the 2 hinge with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
9.
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT OUTER CENTER
(a) Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
10. INSTALL REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Install the armrest with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the armrest cover with the screw.
11. INSTALL REAR SEAT LOCK STRIKER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 strikers with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
12. INSTALL REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Install the hinge with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
13. INSTALL REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the hinge with the bolt.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–31
14. INSTALL REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
SE
SE–24
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY CENTER
REAR SEAT LOCK STRIKER SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR SEATBACK LOCK COVER RH
REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEATBACK STOP BUTTON GROMMET
REAR SEATBACK LOCK RELEASE BUTTON
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY
OUTER CENTER
SE
REAR SEAT
SHOULDER BELT
COVER
18 (184, 13)
18 (184, 13)
42 (428, 31)
REAR SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
37 (377, 27)
REAR SEATBACK HINGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HOG RING
REAR SEATBACK BOARD
CARPET ASSEMBLY RH
SEPARATE TYPE REAR
SEATBACK COVER RH
REAR SEATBACK PAD RH
REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEATBACK TOP TETHER COVER INNER
REAR SEATBACK TOP TETHER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120293E01
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–25
REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMLBY LH
REAR SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
REAR SEATBACK TOP TERHER COVER
REAR SEATBACK TOP TETHER COVER INNER
REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEATBACK PAD LH
SE
SEPARATE TYPE REAR
SEATBACK COVER LH
REAR SEAT ARMREST
ASSEMBLY CENTER
REAR SEATBACK LOCK
RELEASE BUTTON
18 (184, 13)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
HOG RING
37 (377, 27)
REAR SEAT CENTER
ARMREST SUPPORT RH
HOG RING
18 (184, 27)
REAR SEAT ARMREST COVER
REAR SEAT
LOCK STRIKER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEATBACK STOP BUTTON GROMMET
REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEATBACK LOCK COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120294E01
SE–26
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION PAD RH
SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION PAD LH
SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT
CUSHION COVER LH
SE
REAR NO. 1 SEAT HINGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HOG RING
x7
37 (377, 27)
18 (184, 13)
18 (184, 13)
x5
37 (377, 27)
37 (377, 27)
REAR SEAT CUSHION HINGE COVER
REAR SEAT CUSHION HINGE COVER
18 (184, 13)
REAR NO. 1 SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY CENTER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B134256E02
SE–32
SEAT – REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
SE
1.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the seatback with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the seatback with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the cushion with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the 2 hinge covers.
4.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
SE–32
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
LH:
HEADREST
REAR NO. 2 SEAT LH
SEAT NO. 2 BACK PAD LH
SE
SEAT NO. 2
LEG COVER
SEAT NO. 2 BACK COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT NO. 3
LEG COVER
SEAT NO. 2 LEG COVER
HOG RING
NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
HOG RING
SEAT NO. 2 CUSHION PAD LH
Non-reusable part
B120237E01
SE–33
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
LH:
REAR SEAT FRAME
HEADREST SUPPORT
REAR SEATBACK PROTECTOR
REAR SEAT RECLINING
COVER NO. 2 RH
18 (185, 13)
REAR SEAT RECLINING
COVER NO. 2 LH
18 (185, 13)
NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION
CARPET
SCREW COVER
RELEASE HANDLE
NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT BELT INNER
STOPPER BAND
SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120238E02
SE
SE–34
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
RH:
HEADREST
REAR NO. 2 SEAT RH
SEAT NO. 2 LEG COVER
SEAT NO. 3 LEG COVER
SE
SEAT NO. 2 LEG COVER
NO. 2 SEATBACK COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
SEAT NO. 2 BACK PAD RH
HOG RING
NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HOG RING
SEAT NO. 2 SUCHION PAD RH
Non-reusable part
B120239E01
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
SE–35
RH:
HEADREST SUPPORT
REAR SEAT FRAME
REAR SEATBACK
PROTECTOR
SCREW COVER
RELEASE HANDLE
SE
REAR SEAT RECLINING
COVER NO. 2 RH
18 (185, 13)
REAR SEAT RECLINING
COVER NO. 2 LH
NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION
CARPET
18 (185, 13)
STOPPER BAND
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT BELT INNER
NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY
SEAT CUSHION UNDER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120240E02
SE–36
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
REMOVAL
1.
Claw
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disengage the claws and remove the seat leg cover.
B064892E01
(b) Release the rear seat lock and remove the seat.
(c) Remove the headrests.
SE
B064896
DISASSEMBLY
Claw
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 SEATBACK COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
reclining cover LH.
B078862E01
(b) Remove the screw cover, screw and release
handle.
B064894
(c) Disengage the claws and remove the 2 screws and
reclining cover RH.
(d) Open the fastener of the seatback cover and
remove the seatback protector.
(e) Remove the screw and the cushion.
Claw
B064895E01
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
SE–37
(f) Remove the headrest supports.
(g) Remove the seatback cover together with the pad.
(h) Cut the hog rings and remove the seatback cover.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 SEATBACK COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
3.
REMOVE NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Insert a screwdriver between the seat cushion cover
and seat cushion under cover.
NOTICE:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pry the seat cushion cover hem to disengage it.
(c) Cut the hog rings and remove the seat cushion
cover.
4.
REMOVE NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION COVER SUBASSEMBLY RH
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION FRAME SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 4 screws and seat cushion under
cover.
(b) Remove the nut and stopper band.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 springs and seat leg.
B060977
SE
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
SE–39
REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH
Side)
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
HEADREST
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HINGE COVER NO. 3 RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HINGE COVER NO. 2 RH
37 (375, 27)
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HINGE COVER NO. 2 LH
37 (375, 27)
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HINGE COVER NO. 3 LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120232E01
SE
SE–40
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
REAR SEAT BELT SHOULDER COVER
REAR SEAT 3-POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY LH
HEADREST SUPPORT
REAR SEATBACK FRAME
42 (430, 31)
SE
REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER NO. 1
TETHER ANCHOR
COVER
REAR SEAT SHOULDER
BELT HOLE COVER LH
REAR SEAT RECLINING
COVER INNER LH
ARMREST COVER
REAR SEAT PROTECTOR
REAR SEATBACK PAD
REAR SEATBACK COVER
REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSEMBLY CENTER
ARMREST HINGE
B120233E01
SE–41
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type LH Side)
REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER RH
SEATBACK
STOPPER
PLATE
REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER LH
REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER RH
FOLD SEAT LOCK CONTROL CABLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR NO. 1 SEAT LOCK
CABLE ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL
WIRE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RECLINING COVER RH
HOG RING
SE
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT
BELT INNER
REAR SEAT
CUSHION PAD
REAR SEAT CUSHION FRAME
RELEASE HANDLE LH
REAR SEAT BELT INNER NO. 2
HINGE COVER
PIN
SPRING
PROTECTOR
E-RING
REAR SEAT HINGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
SPRING
SEAT STAY
SCREW
COVER
GUIDE
PIN
E-RING
REAR SEAT HINGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
PIN
REAR SEAT CUSHION
UNDER COVER
PROTECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
RECLINING
COVER LH
Non-reusable part
B120234E01
SE–38
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 SEAT CUSHION FRAME SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the spring between the seat frame and seat
leg.
(b) Install the seat leg with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the stopper band with the nut.
(d) Install the seat cushion under cover with the 4
screws.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seat belt inner with the nut.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 SEAT CUSHION COVER SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the the seat cushion
cover with new hog rings.
(b) Place the seat cushion cover together with the pad
on the seat frame.
(c) Engage the seat cushion cover hem to the seat
cushion under cover securely.
4.
INSTALL NO. 2 SEATBACK COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover with
new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover together with the pad to
the seat frame.
(c) Install the headrest supports.
(d) Install the seatback protector.
(e) Close the fastener of the seatback cover.
(f) Install the cushion with the screw.
SE
(g) Install the reclining cover RH with the 2 screws.
Claw
B064895E01
(h) Install the release handle with the screw.
(i) Install the screw cover.
B064894
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(j)
SE–39
Install the reclining cover LH with the 2 screws.
Claw
B078862E01
SE
SE–48
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH
Side)
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
HEADREST
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HENGE COVER NO. 3 RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HINGE COVER NO. 2 RH
37 (375, 27)
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HENGE COVER NO. 3 LH
SE
37 (375, 27)
REAR SEAT CUSHION
HINGE COVER NO. 2 LH
HEADREST SUPPORT
REAR SEATBACK FRAME
REAR SEATBACK PAD
REAR SEATBACK COVER
TETHER
ANCHOR COVER
REAR SEAT RECLINING
COVER INNER LH
REAR SEAT
RECLINING
COVER INNER RH
HOG RING
50 (510, 37)
REAR SEAT PROTECTOR
RECLINING COVER INNER RH
HOG RING
REAR SEAT CUSHION PAD
RECLINING COVER INNER LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B142557E01
SE–49
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 60/40 Split Seat Type RH Side)
REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL
WIRE SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR NO. 1 SEAT LOCK CABLE ASSEMBLY
FOLD SEAT LOCK CONTROL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RELEASE HANDLE LH
SE
SCREW COVER
REAR SEAT HINGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
RECLINING COVER RH
SEAT STAY
REAR SEAT CUSHION FRAME
E-RING
REAR SEAT
BELT INNER
HINGE COVER
PIN
SPRING
PROTECTOR
GUIDE
SPRING
PIN
E-RING
42 (430, 31)
RECLINING
COVER LH
PROTECTOR
PIN
REAR SEAT HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION
UNDER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120236E01
SE–40
SEAT – REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
INSTALLATION
1.
SE
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the headrests.
(b) Install the seat.
(c) Install the seat leg cover.
SE–54
SEAT – POWER SEAT SWITCH
POWER SEAT SWITCH
Slide Switch
Reclining Switch
INSPECTION
1.
Front Vertical Switch
Lifter Switch
RCLF
E
SE
B
RCLR
INSPECT FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH
(a) Check the resistance between the terminals when
each switch is operated.
Standard resistance:
Slide switch
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (B) - 9 (SLDF)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 6 (SLDR)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 6 (SLDR)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 9 (SLDF)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (B) - 6 (SLDR)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
1 (E) - 6 (SLDF)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
Front vertical switch
FUP
SLDF
LDWN
LUP
SLDR
FDWN
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (B) - 10 (FUP)
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 5 (FDWN)
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 5 (FDWN)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
B105970E02
4 (E) - 10 (FUP)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (B) - 5 (FDWN)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 10 (FUP)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
Rear vertical switch
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (B) - 7 (LUP)
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 8 (LDWN)
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 7 (LUP)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 8 (LDWN)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (B) - 8 (LDWN)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 7 (LUP)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (B) - 3 (RCLF)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2 (RCLR) - 4 (E)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2 (RCLR) - 4 (E)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
Reclining switch
3 (RCLF) - 4 (E)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (B) - 2 (RCLR)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
3 (RCLF) - 4 (E)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
SE–55
SEAT – POWER SEAT SWITCH
2.
Reclining Switch
E
Slide Switch
RCLF RCLR
B
INSPECT FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH RH
(a) Inspect the front passenger side power seat switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance:
Slide switch
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (B) - 9 (SLDF)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4 (B) - 6 (SLDR)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4 (B) - 6 (SLDR)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 9 (SLDF)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (B) - 6 (SLDR)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
4 (E) - 9 (SLDF)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
Reclining switch
SLDF
SLDR
B111877E01
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (B) - 3 (RCLF)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2 (RCLR) - 4 (E)
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2 (RCLR) - 4 (E)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
3 (RCLF) - 4 (E)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (B) - 2 (RCLR)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
3 (RCLF) - 4 (E)
REAR
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the
switch.
SE
SE–56
Slide Motor:
Counterclockwise
SEAT – FRONT SEAT FRAME WITH ADJUSTER
Clockwise
FRONT SEAT FRAME WITH
ADJUSTER
INSPECTION
1.
Driving Axis
B073550E24
SE
INSPECT FRONT SEAT ADJUSTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Check operation of the slide motor.
(1) Check if the rotates smoothly when the battery
is connected to the slide motor connector
terminals.
OK
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the slide
motor.
Front Vertical
Motor:
Clockwise
Counterclockwise
Driving Axis
B073550E25
(b) Check operation of the vertical motor.
(1) Check if the rotates smoothly when the battery
is connected to the vertical motor connector
terminals.
OK
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the
vertical motor.
Rear Vertical
Motor:
Clockwise
Counterclockwise
Driving Axis
B073550E26
(c) Check operation of the rear vertical motor.
(1) Check if the rotates smoothly when the battery
is connected to the vertical motor connector
terminals.
OK
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
frame with adjuster.
SE–57
SEAT – FRONT SEAT FRAME WITH ADJUSTER
Reclining Motor:
Counterclockwise
(d) Check operation of the reclining motor.
(1) Check if the rotates smoothly when the battery
is connected to the reclining motor connector
terminals
OK
Clockwise
Driving Axis
B073550E27
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the
reclining motor.
Slide Motor:
Counterclockwise
2.
Clockwise
Driving Axis
B073550E24
INSPECT FRONT SEAT ADJUSTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Check operation of the slide motor.
(1) Check if the rotates smoothly when the battery
is connected to the slide motor connector
terminals.
OK
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the slide
motor.
Reclining Motor:
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
Driving Axis
B073550E27
(b) Check operation of the reclining motor.
(1) Check if the rotates smoothly when the battery
is connected to the reclining motor connector
terminals
OK
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the
reclining motor.
SE
SE–58
SEAT – FRONT POWER SEAT LUMBAR SWITCH
HOLD
RELEASE
FRONT POWER SEAT LUMBAR
SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
SE
E1
H
B
E2
R
B068208E01
INSPECT FRONT POWER SEAT LUMBAR SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Position
Specified Condition
1 (R) - 2 (E2)
HOLD
Below 1 Ω
3 (B) - 4 (H)
HOLD
Below 1 Ω
1 (R) - 2 (E2)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 (H) - 5 (E1)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (R) - 3 (B)
RELEASE
Below 1 Ω
4 (H) - 5 (E1)
RELEASE
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
SE–59
SEAT – LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
Counterclockwise
LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY
Clockwise
INSPECTION
1.
Driving Axis
B068209E01
INSPECT LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Only on the driver side:
(1) Check operation of the lumbar support adjuster
motor.
Standard
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the
lumbar support adjuster assembly motor.
SE
SE–60
SEAT – SEAT HEATER SWITCH
SEAT HEATER SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
B065858
INSPECT SEAT HEATER SWITCH LH
(a) Check the resistance between the terminals when
the switch is operated.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-4
ON (MAX)
Below 1 Ω
5-6
ON (MAX)
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
4-5
ON (MIN)
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Illumination circuit
Below 1 Ω
(b) Inspect the seat heater switch indicator.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 3 and the negative (-) lead to
terminal 1.
(2) Push the seat heater switch ON and check that
the indicator lights up.
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
heater switch and inspect the circuits
connected to the other parts.
SE
(c) Inspect the seat heater switch illumination.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 6 and the negative (-) lead to
terminal 5.
(2) Check that the illumination lights up.
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
heater switch or bulb.
B065621
2.
B065858
INSPECT SEAT HEATER SWITCH RH
(a) Check the resistance between the terminals when
the switch is operated.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-4
ON (MAX)
Below 1 Ω
5-6
ON (MAX)
Below 1 Ω
-
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
4-5
ON (MIN)
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Illumination circuit
Below 1 Ω
(b) Inspect the seat heater switch indicator.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 3 and the negative (-) lead to
terminal 1.
SEAT – SEAT HEATER SWITCH
SE–61
(2) Push the seat heater switch ON and check that
the indicator lights up.
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
heater switch and inspect the circuits
connected to the other parts.
(c) Inspect the seat heater switch illumination.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery
to terminal 6 and the negative (-) lead to
terminal 5.
(2) Check that the illumination lights up.
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
heater switch or bulb.
B065621
SE
SE–62
SEAT – FRONT SEATBACK HEATER
FRONT SEATBACK HEATER
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT SEATBACK HEATER LH
(a) Check seatback heater resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Below 1 Ω
B065623E01
If the result is not as specified, replace the seatback
cover assembly.
2.
SE
INSPECT FRONT SEATBACK HEATER RH
(a) Check seatback heater resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the seatback
cover assembly.
B065623E01
SE–63
SEAT – FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER
FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER
A
B
INSPECTION
1.
B065624E01
INSPECT FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER LH
(a) Check the seat cushion heater resistance between
the terminal.
(1) Apply battery voltage and check the seat
cushion heater.
Standard resistance
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
A1 - B2
Below 1 Ω
A4 - B2
Below 1 Ω
A1 - A4
Below 1 Ω
A2 - A3
Below 1 Ω
B1 - B2
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
cushion cover assembly.
2.
A
B
INSPECT FRONT SEAT CUSHION HEATER RH
(a) Check the seat cushion heater resistance between
the terminal.
(1) Apply battery voltage and check the seat
cushion heater.
Standard resistance
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
A1 - B2
Below 1 Ω
A4 - B2
Below 1 Ω
A1 - A4
Below 1 Ω
A2 - A3
Below 1 Ω
B1 - B2
Below 1 Ω
B065624E01
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat
cushion cover assembly.
SE
SE–64
SEAT – SEAT HEATER CONTROL
SEAT HEATER CONTROL
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT SEAT HEATER CONTROL LH
(a) Disconnect the seat heater control LH connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance according to
the value(s) in the table below.
Standard
Wire Harness SIde:
No Pin
Tester Connection
No Pin
2.
Wire Harness SIde:
No Pin
Specified Condition
6 - Body ground
Constant
Below 1 Ω
1-6
(Seat heater switch)
OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V
4-6
Constant
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side or seat heater
switch.
B031234E03
SE
Condition
INSPECT FRONT SEAT HEATER CONTROL RH
(a) Disconnect the seat heater control RH connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance according to
the value(s) in the table below.
Standard
Tester Connection
No Pin
B031234E03
Condition
Specified Condition
6 - Body ground
Constant
Below 1 Ω
1-6
(Seat heater switch)
OFF → ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V
4-6
Constant
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side or seat heater
switch.
ED–4
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
ED
INSPECT BASIC OPERATION
(a) When the back door is partially closed, check that
the motor operates so that the back door is fully
closed (locked).
(b) After the above step, check that the back door can
be opened.
(c) When the back door is partially closed and then the
motor starts normal operation, push the back door
opener switch and pull up the back door to open it.
At this time, check that the motor starts reverse
operation and then stops.
(d) Immediately after the back door is partially closed
(the motor has not started operation yet), push the
back door opener switch to open the back door.
Check that the motor does not operate at this time.
ED–5
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM:
Symptom
Back door closer does not operate
Suspected area
See page
1. with Motor back door lock assembly (back door lock)
ED-11
2. Multiplex network door ECU back (back door ECU)
ED-11
3. Wire harness
-
ED
ED–6
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
(BACK DOOR ECU)
B9
B8
B062706E04
(a) Disconnect the B8 and B9 ECU connectors, and
check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of
the wire harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
ED
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
BDR (B8-4) - Body Ground
L--
Constant
10 to 14 V
BECU (B8-5) - Body Ground
L-R - -
Constant
10 to 14 V
GND (B8-3) - Body Ground
W-B - -
Constant
Continuity
No key inserted in ignition key cylinder
→ Key inserted
No continuity → Continuity
Back door opener switch OFF → ON
No continuity → Continuity
SIG (B8-6) - Body Ground
B--
HSW+ (B9-10) - Body Ground
V-W - -
HSW- (B9-22) - Body Ground
LG-R - -
HALF (B9-6) - Body Ground
R-G - -
Back door OPEN → CLOSED
Continuity → No continuity
LSE (B9-21) - Body Ground
B-R - -
Constant
Continuity
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the connectors, and check the voltage of
each terminal of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
L-B - -
Back door OPEN → NOT
COMPLETELY CLOSED → Motor in
normal rotation (Right turn) → Motor in
revers rotation (Left turn) → Operation
completed (Back door CLOSED)
Below 1 V → Below 1 V → 10
to14 V → Below 1 V → Below 1
V
ACT- (B9-14) - Body Ground
L-R - -
Back door OPEN → NOT
COMPLETELY CLOSED → Motor in
normal rotation (Right turn) → Motor in
revers rotation (Left turn) → Operation
completed (Back door CLOSED)
Below 1 V → Below 1 V →
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
FULL (B9-7) - Body Ground
G-Y - -
Back door CLOSED → OPEN
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
POS (B9-8) - Body Ground
BR-W - -
Back door OPEN → Closer in operation
→ CLOSED
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
ACT+ (B9-15) - Body Ground
If the result is not as specified, the vehicle may be
defective. In this case, check the harness,
connector and fuse between the ECU and battery.
Then repair or replace it if necessary.
ED–7
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
2.
3.
CG SG CANH SIL
DESCRIPTION
The ECU stores trouble codes when trouble occurs on
the vehicle.
The diagnostic system allows for reading of the trouble
codes from the DLC3.
Use the intelligent tester to check and solve the problem.
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) Check the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 10 V, replace the battery
before proceed to the next step.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle's ECU uses ISO 9141-2 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement
of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches
the ISO 9141-2 format.
ED
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
G039021E01
(b) Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch to the ON
position and attempt to use the intelligent tester. If
the screen displays a communication error
message, a problem exists in the vehicle side or
tester side.
HINT:
• If communication is normal when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the tool
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
ED–8
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
G039021E01
2.
ED
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester's screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester's screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
ED–9
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the intelligent
tester, you can read the value of the switch, sensor,
actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the
DATA LIST as a first step of troubleshooting is one of the
method to shorten the labor time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, read the DATA
LIST.
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
KEY SW(UNLK)
Back door key lock and
unlock SW signal/ ON or
OFF
ON: Back door lock key cylinder is turned to unlock
OFF: Key is in back door lock key cylinder (Neutral
position)
-
KEY SW(LOCK)
Back door key lock and
unlock SW signal/ ON or
OFF
ON: Back door lock key cylinder is turned to lock
OFF: Key is in back door lock key cylinder (Neutral
position)
-
HALF LATCH SW
Back door half latch SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Back door is open
OFF: Back door is closed
-
FULL LATCH SW
Back door full latch SW
(courtesy SW) signal/ON
or OFF
ON: Back door is closed
OFF: Back door is open
-
DOOR HANDLE SW
Back door opener SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Back door opener is pushed
OFF: Back door opener is not pushed
-
LOCK STATUS
Back door position SW
signal/UNLOCK or LOCK
UNLOCK: Back door is unlock
LOCK: Back door is lock
-
Normal Condition
2.
Item
LATCH RELEASE
Diagnostic Note
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate
without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as
a first step of troubleshooting is one of the method to
shorten the labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, perform the
ACTIVE TEST.
Test Details
Back door lock latch is release ON/OFF
Diagnostic Note
-
ED
ED–10
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the circuit listed for that code in the table below.
(Proceed to the page given for that circuit.)
BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM:
DTC No.
B2215
ED
Detection Item
Back Door Closer Switch
Malfunction
Trouble Area
1. with Motor back door lock
assembly (back door lock)
2. Multiplex network door ECU
back (back door ECU)
3. Wire harness
See page
ED-8
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–35
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR WIRE LH
(a) Install the door wire with the 2 bolts.
Torque: Reference
8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
In order to prevent water leakage, be sure that
the lip of the rubber grommet dose not turn up
or is not deformed when installing the door wire.
(b) Connect the door wire clips.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding parts of the door
check.
(b) Install the door check to the door panel with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(c) Apply adhesive to the bolt.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(d) Install the door check to the body panel with the
bolt.
Torque: 30 N*m (306 kgf*cm, 22 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Install the door check so that rivet head is up.
B062428
B062429E03
Bolt
B062427E02
3.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), install the
outside handle frame with the screw.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the outside handle pad front and rear.
4.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of
the door lock.
(b) Install a new door lock wire harness packing.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the door lock that is removed,
replace the packing in the connecting part
with a new one.
• Be careful that no grease and dirt will stick to
the packing surface in the connecting part.
• Reusing the packing that is removed or using
a damaged packing will cause water to
penetrate through the connecting part, and it
will result in a malfunction of the door lock.
(c) Insert the outside handle link into the lock with the
door motor, and then set it to the door panel.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the outside handle link is
securely engaged with the lock assembly.
ED
ED–36
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
(d) Apply adhesive to the 3 screws.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(e) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), install the door
lock with the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 42 in.*lbf)
(f) Connect the door lock connector.
B062426E01
ED
Hole Plug
5.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), install the
outside handle cover with the screw.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the hole plug.
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR LOWER LH
(a) Install the door frame with the bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 42 in.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Align the matchmarks on the regulator motor gear
and regulator gear.
(b) Using a "torx" driver (T25), install the door regulator
motor with the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
HINT:
Never rotate the motor to the down direction until
the window glass installation has done.
8.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of
the window regulator.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease to the spring of the window
regulator.
B061438E23
B062425E02
B062430
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–37
(b) Install the window regulator with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the window regulator connector.
NOTICE:
Be careful not drop and deform the door window
regulator.
9.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
NOTICE:
Do not damage the door glass.
B062424E01
(a) Install the glass run.
(b) Insert the door glass into the door panel along the
glass run, as shown in the illustration.
(1)
(2)
ED
B062423E14
B062422E01
(c) Install the door glass to the window regulator with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(d) Inspect operation of the power window.
HINT:
When the installation point of the door glass does
not match, adjust the regulator position in the
manual operation.
(1) Connect the power window switch to the wire
harness and turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Repeat UP and DOWN operation several times
in the manual operation.
10. INSTALL FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 speaker bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the speaker connector.
(c) Install the No. 2 speaker with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
B062421E01
ED–38
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
11. INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the outer rear view mirror with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the outer rear view mirror connector.
B062419
12. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Apply butyl tape to the door, as shown in the
illustration.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08850-00065, Butyl Tape Set or
equivalent
(b) Install the service hole cover.
Standard dimension
Referance
Point
A
ED
Butyl Tape
B
B062414E01
Area
Measurement
A
6 mm (0.236 in.)
B
2 mm (0.079 in.)
HINT:
• When installing the service hole cover, pull out
the links and connectors through the service hole
cover.
• There should be no wrinkles or folds after
attaching the service hole cover.
• After attaching the service hole cover, check the
sealing condition.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–41
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
Claw
1.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the inside handle bezel.
2.
REMOVE REAR ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disengage the 4 claws, remove the armrest
assembly.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B062416E03
Claw
Claw
: Claw B062417E01
3.
: Clips
B062434E01
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the cushion rubbers.
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
(c) Using a clip remover, disengage the 12 clips,
remove the 12 clips.
(d) Remove the trim board upward.
HINT:
In order to prevent the door from being damaged,
cover the parts indicated by arrow marks in the
illustration with tape.
(e) Disconnect the 2 cables from the inside handle.
(f) Remove the trim board.
(g) Remove the inner weatherstrip.
H006127E03
ED
ED–42
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
B065761E01
ED
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the rear door service hole cover LH.
NOTICE:
Remove the remaining tape on the door side.
5.
REMOVE REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (See page AV205)
6.
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
FRONT LH (See page ET-66)
7.
REMOVE REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
OUTER (See page ET-32)
8.
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW DIVISION BAR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
HINT:
Insert a shop rag inside the door panel to prevent the
glass from being scratched.
(a) Open the door glass until the bolts appear in the
service hole.
(b) Remove the door glass from the glass bracket and
lower the door glass into the door panel.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the door glass.
HINT:
Position the door glass toward the front as much as
possible.
(c) Remove the rear door glass run.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts, screw and the division bar.
B062435E01
(e) Rotate the division bar by 90° and pull it upward as
shown in the illustration.
90q
B063574E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
9.
B063661E01
B062437
ED–43
REMOVE REAR DOOR QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
LH
(a) Remove the quarter glass, as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the glass.
(b) Remove the quarter window weatherstrip from the
glass.
10. REMOVE REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Carefully pull up the glass out of the panel.
HINT:
Insert a shop rag inside the door panel to prevent
the glass from being scratched.
11. REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the window regulator connector.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and window regulator.
NOTICE:
When the bolts are removed, the rear door
window regulator might drop and be deformed.
HINT:
Remove the window regulator through the service
hole.
12. REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Place matchmarks on the window regulator motor
gear and regulator gear.
(b) Using a "torx" driver (T25), remove the 3 screws
and window regulator motor.
13. REMOVE REAR DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the door lock connector.
(b) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), remove the 3
screws and door lock.
HINT:
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
(c) Remove the door lock wire harness packing.
B062438E01
14. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), loosen the
screw and remove the outside handle cover.
15. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Pull and hold the release plate of the outside handle
frame, as shown in the illustration.
B057767
ED
ED–44
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
(b) Pushing and pulling the outside handle in the arrow
mark direction as shown in the illustration, remove
the outside handle.
NOTICE:
If the release plate is not pulled and held when
removing the outside handle, the release plate
will interfere with the outside handle and it will
damage the release plate.
(c) Remove the 2 outside handle pad front and rear.
(1)
(2)
B056613E13
16. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), loosen the
screw.
(b) Slide the outside handle frame from to remove it.
HINT:
Remove the outside handle frame through the
service hole.
Bolt
ED
B062442E01
17. REMOVE REAR DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, bolt and door check.
HINT:
Remove the door check through the service hole.
B062429
18. REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
(a) Using a clip remover, disengage the clip, remove
the weatherstrip.
HINT:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
ED–1
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
- BODY ECU
UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSEMBLY
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
ED
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
- DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
BACK DOOR OPENER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR
ECU (BACK DOOR ECU)
WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY (BACK DOOR LOCK)
B120218E01
ED–2
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedures on the
following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
ED
(a) Check that there is no abnormality in the communication
system by inspecting the communication function of the
multiplex communication system with the intelligent
tester.
(1) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal)
Without code outputs, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal)
With code outputs, proceed to B.
B
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SECTION
A
4
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
(a) Check the diagnostic trouble code.
(1) Without code outputs, proceed to A.
(2) With code outputs, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 6
A
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Without applicable symptoms, proceed to A.
(b) With applicable symptoms, proceed to B.
B
A
Go to step 6
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
6
ED–3
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING IN FOLLOWING METHOD, DEPENDING ON
MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
(a) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (See page ED-6)
(1) Inspection with the intelligent tester (DATA LIST)
(2) Inspection with the intelligent tester (ACTIVE TEST)
(b) TERMINALS OF ECU (See page ED-4)
NEXT
7
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
END
ED
ED–45
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
• Before adjusting the door position for vehicles equipped
with side airbags and curtain shield airbags, be sure to
disconnect the battery. After adjustment, inspect the SRS
warning light, the side airbag system and the curtain shield
airbag system for normal operation. Then initialize both
systems.
• Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSPECT REAR DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check that the clearance is within the standard
value.
D
B
A
ED
C
E
B062431E01
Standard clearance
2.
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E01
Area
Measurement
A
5.0 +- 1.5 mm (0.197 +- 0.059 in.)
B
5.6 +- 1.5 mm (0.024 +- 0.059 in.)
C
8.8 +- 1.5 mm (0.343 +- 0.059 in.)
D
160 mm (6.30 in.)
E
4.5 +- 1.5 mm (0.177 +- 0.059 in.)
ADJUST REAR DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Adjust the rear door panel position.
HINT:
• Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge
to the vehicle body and door. The door cannot be
adjusted with the centering bolts on. Substitute
the centering bolts with standard bolts (w/
washers) when making adjustments.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in
the standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
ED–46
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
(1) Adjust the door forward/rearward and vertically
by loosening the body side hinge bolts.
(2) Tighten the body side hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
B062432
(3) Horizontally and vertically adjust the door by
loosening the door side hinge bolts.
(4) Tighten the body side hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
ED
B062433
(5) Adjust the striker position by slightly loosening
the striker mounting screws and hitting the
striker with a plastic-faced hammer.
(6) Tighten the striker mounting screws after the
adjustment.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
(7) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable from
the battery.
(8) Initialize both systems.
(9) Check the SRS warning lamp.
B062439E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
Adhesive
B062429E05
INSTALL REAR DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding part of the door
check.
(b) Install the door check to the door panel with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(c) Apply adhesive to the bolt.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(d) Install the door check to the body panel with the
bolt.
Torque: 30 N*m (306 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Install the door check so that rivet head is up.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–47
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), install the
handle frame with the screw.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the outside handle pad front and rear.
(b) Pull and hold the release plate of the outside handle
frame, as shown in the illustration.
Bolt
B062442E02
ED
B057767
(c) Pushing the outside handle in the arrow mark
direction as shown in the illustration, install the
outside handle.
NOTICE:
If the release plate is not pulled and held when
installing the outside handle, the release plate
will interfere with the outside handle and it will
damage the release plate.
(2)
(1)
4.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), install the
outside handle cover with the screw.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WITH MOTOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of
the door lock.
(b) Install a new door lock wire harness packing.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the door lock that is removed,
replace the packing in the connecting part
with a new one.
• Be careful that no grease and dirt will stick to
the packing surface in the connecting part.
• Reusing the packing that is removed or using
a damaged packing will cause water to
penetrate through the connecting part, and it
will result in a malfunction of the door lock.
B064044E14
ED–48
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
(c) Engage the lock with door motor with the release
plate of the outside handle, and then set it to the
door panel.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the release plate of the outside
handle frame is securely engaged with the lock.
(d) Apply adhesive to the 3 screws.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
(e) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), install the door
lock with the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 42 in.*lbf)
(f) Connect the door lock connector.
6.
INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a "torx" driver (T25), install the door window
regulator motor with the 3 screws.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of
the window regulator.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease to the spring of the window
regulator.
B062438E01
ED
B062440
(b) Install the door window regulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop and deform the rear door
window regulator.
(c) Connect the window regulator connector.
8.
INSTALL REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop and deform the front door
window regulator.
(a) Insert the rear door glass into the door panel.
HINT:
• Insert a shop rag inside the door panel to prevent
the door glass from being scratched.
• Position the door glass toward the front as much
as possible.
9.
INSTALL REAR DOOR QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
LH
(a) Install the quarter window weatherstrip to the door
glass.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the glass.
B062437
ED–49
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
(b) Install the door quarter window glass as shown in
the illustration.
B063661E02
10. INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW DIVISION BAR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Insert the division bar to the door panel, then rotate
it by 90° as shown in the illustration.
(b) Mount the door glass to the window regulator.
90°
ED
B063574E02
B062435E02
(c) Tighten the division bar with the 2 bolts and screw.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the glass run.
HINT:
When the installation point of the door glass does
not match, adjust the regulator position in manual
operation.
(1) Connect the power window switch to the wire
harness and turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Repeat UP and DOWN operation several times
in manual operation.
11. INSTALL REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Apply butyl tape to the door, as shown in the
illustration.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08850-00065, Butyl Tape Set or
equivalent
(b) Install the service hole cover.
Standard dimension
Referance
Point
A
B
Butyl Tape
B062441E01
Area
Measurement
A
6 mm (0.236 in.)
B
2 mm (0.079 in.)
HINT:
• When installing the service hole cover, pull out
the links and connectors through the service hole
cover.
• There should be no wrinkles or folds after
attaching the service hole cover.
• After attaching the service hole cover, check the
sealing condition.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–53
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (See page IP-6).
: Clip
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD
(a) Remove the assist strap hole cover.
(b) Remove the screw and assist strap.
(c) Using a screwdriver, remove the back door trim
cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
In order to prevent the back door from being
damaged, cover the parts indicated by arrow marks
in the illustration with tape.
(d) Using a clip remover, remove the 10 clips and trim
board.
(e) Remove the inner weatherstrip.
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the back door service hole cover LH.
NOTICE:
Remove the remaining tape on the back door
side.
B062858E01
3.
B062865E02
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Remove the 5 screws and service hole cover.
HINT:
• Do not disconnect the multiplex network door
ECU connector.
• Fix the multiplex network door ECU with tape.
• If the door lock protector are damaged, exchange
it for new door lock protector.
(b) Open the door glass until the bolts appear in the
service hole.
(c) Remove the door glass run.
HINT:
Since removing the glass run will make the glass
loose, insert shop rug between the door glass and
body panel.
(d) Disconnect the window defogger connector.
B062860E01
(e) Remove the 4 bolts and door glass.
B062861E01
ED
ED–54
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
(f) Remove the door glass as shown in the illustration.
(g) Disconnect the rear window connector.
(h) Remove the multiplex network door ECU.
(2)
(1)
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ASSEMBLY OUTER (See page ET-35)
5.
REMOVE WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the back door lock connector.
B062862E01
(b) Remove the 2 back window regulator control wires.
ED
B063578E01
(c) Disengage the 2 claws and remove the lock
protector as shown in the illustration.
(d) Remove the 4 bolts and back door lock.
HINT:
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
B062863
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 cushion rubbers.
(b) Disconnect the window regulator connector.
(c) Remove the 6 bolts, nut and window regulator.
HINT:
Remove the power window regulator through the
service hole.
7.
REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH REAR
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and window regulator motor.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and cover plate.
(c) Using needle nose pliers, remove the drum and wire
guide from the motor.
NOTICE:
Do not use a screwdriver, etc. when removing
them.
B062864
B065134
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
8.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the liner wiper step LH as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Remove the rear wiper motor assembly (See page
WW-31).
9.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the tailgate control switch.
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and lock cylinder.
HINT:
Remove the back door lock cylinder assembly
through the service hole.
(2) Pull
(1) Push
B063660E01
ED–55
10. REMOVE BACK DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE (See page ET-70)
11. REMOVE TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
View Monitor System) (See page PM-16)
12. REMOVE BACK DOOR STOPPER LOWER
(a) Remove the bolt and stopper lower.
13. REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER STOPPER CUSHION
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and stopper cushion.
14. REMOVE REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
Spoiler) (See page ET-19)
15. REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
Spoiler) (See page LI-58)
16. REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (w/o
Rear Spoiler) (See page LI-58)
ED
ED–56
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ADJUSTMENT
1.
INSPECT BACK DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the clearance is within the standard
value.
B
C
A
ED
B062447E01
Standard clearance
2.
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E01
Area
Measurement
A
6.5 +- 1.5 mm (0.296 +- 0.059 in.)
B
10.0 +- 1.5 mm (0.394 +- 0.059 in.)
C
15.0 +- 1.5 mm (0.591 +- 0.059 in.)
ADJUST BACK DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Adjust the back door panel position.
HINT:
• Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge
to the vehicle body and door. The door cannot be
adjusted with the centering bolts on. Substitute
the centering bolts with standard bolts (w/
washers) when making adjustments.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in
the standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
(1) Adjust the door horizontally and forward/
rearward by loosening the body side hinge
nuts.
(2) Tighten the body side hinge nuts after
adjustment.
Torque: 19.5 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
B062448
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–57
(3) Horizontally and vertically adjust the back door
by loosening the back door side hinge bolts.
(4) Tighten the back door side hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 19.5 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
B062857
(5) Adjust the striker position by slightly loosening
the striker mounting screws and hitting the
striker with a plastic-faced hammer.
(6) Tighten the striker mounting screws after the
adjustment.
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 ft.*lbf)
ED
B063576
(7) Adjust the door stopper, as shown in the
illustration, so that the door can be opened/
closed smoothly.
(8) Tighten the door stopper after the adjustment.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 ft.*lbf)
B063575E01
ED–58
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
REASSEMBLY
ED
1.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
Spoiler) (See page ET-20)
2.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (w/o
Rear Spoiler)
3.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
Spoiler) (See page ET-20)
4.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER STOPPER CUSHION
(a) Install the lower stopper cushion with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL BACK DOOR STOPPER LOWER
(a) Install the stopper lower with the bolt.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
View Monitor System) (See page PM-16)
7.
INSTALL BACK DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE
8.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
(a) Install the lock cylinder with 2 the nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the tailgate control switch.
9.
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear wiper motor assembly (See page
WW-33).
(b) Install the liner wiper step LH.
10. INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH REAR
HINT:
• To prevent the drum and cable from coming off, do not
tilt the drum, subject it to shocks or use force on it.
• If the cable comes off the drum, do not rewind the
cable and do not reuse it.
• After installing the window regulator, do not operate it
by itself, because some types of regulator do not have
a stopper.
(a) Apply MP grease to the as shown in the illustration.
MP Grease
B062867E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–59
(b) With the holding tool installed, match the holding
tool with the motor housing.
B062868
(c) Push down on the wire guide and drum, and insert
the drum into the motor housing.
NOTICE:
If you can not insert the drum into the motor,
slowly slide the bracket for installing the glass,
and insert the drum while aligning the drive
shaft of the motor with the drum.
ED
B062869
(d) Install the cover plate with the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the window regulator motor with the window
regulator.
B062870
11. INSTALL BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of
the window regulator.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease to the spring of the window
regulator.
B063579
(b) Install the power regulator sub-assembly with the 6
bolts, nut.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the window regulator connector.
(d) Install the 2 cushion rubbers.
B062864
ED–60
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
12. INSTALL W/MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the door lock with 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
(c) Install the door lock protector.
B062863
(d) Install the 2 regulator control wires as shown in the
illustration.
ED
B063578E01
13. INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Insert the door glass as shown in the illustration.
(1)
(2)
B062862E02
(b) Install the door glass with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the rear window defogger connector.
B062861
14. INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS RUN
(a) Install the door glass run.
(b) Check that the glass run position as shown in the
illustration.
Align
B063659E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–61
15. INSTALL BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) If replacing protector:
Install the protector, as shown in the illustration.
(b) Install the back door service hole cover with the 5
bolts.
(c) Install the multiplexnetwork door ECU with the 2
bolts.
(d) Connect the multiplexnetwork door ECU connector.
Protector
B062866E01
Referance
Point
Butyl Tape
B062865E01
16. INSTALL BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Apply butyl tape to the door.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08850-00065, Butyl Tape Set or
equivalent
(b) Install the service hole cover, as shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
• There should be no wrinkles or folds after
attaching the service hole cover.
• After attaching the service hole cover, check the
sealing condition.
ED
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
ED–63
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR DUMPER STAY SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the damper stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: Door side
19.5 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
Body side
17.5 N*m (180 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
ED
ED–64
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
1.
a
A
b
B
B065104E15
ED
DISPOSE OF BACK DOOR DUMPER STAY SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Horizontally fix the stay in a vise with the piston-rod
pulled out.
(b) Wearing safety glasses, gradually cut a part
between A and B as shown in the illustration using a
metal saw to gradually release the gas.
Specification
Area
Measurement
a
80 mm (3.15 in.)
b
20 mm (0.80 in.)
CAUTION:
Be careful to cover the area that is being cut as
there is a possibility that metal debris could be
blown out by the gas (the gas is colorless,
odorless and harmless).
ED–11
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
DTC
B2215
Back Door Closer Switch Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the position switch in the back door malfunctions. This position switch detects
the back door LOCK/UNLOCK and sends it to the back door ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
•
B2215
Back door does not operate
•
•
with Motor back door lock assembly (back door
lock)
Multiplex network door ECU back (back door ECU)
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
B7
with Motor Back Door Lock Assembly
(Back Door Lock)
ED
4
BR-W
8
B9 POS
3
B-R
21
B9 LSE
B064456E01
ED–12
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU - W/MOTOR
BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the B7 back door lock and B9 back door
ECU connectors.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the back
door lock (B7) and back door ECU (B9) connectors.
Standard (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
B7
Back Door Lock
Symbols (Terminal No.)
- (B7-4) - POS (B9-8)
- (B7-3) - LSE (B9-21)
NG
B9
Back Door ECU
Specified Condition
Continuity
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
ED
B066168E01
OK
2
INSPECT WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Check operation of the door lock.
(1) Using a screwdriver, push the latch in order to put
the back door lock in the locked condition (full-latch
position).
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and the
negative (-) lead to terminal 2. Then, check
operation of the latch.
Standard:
The latch turns to the open-latch position
(3) Inspect motor operation when battery voltage is
applied to the terminals.
Standard
Fuel-latch
Open-latch
B065423E01
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) - Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) - Terminal 1
Clockwise (Motor in normal rotation)
Battery positive (+) - Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) - Terminal 2
Counterclockwise (Motor in reverse
rotation)
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
ED–13
(b) Check the back door courtesy switch continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
courtesy switch.
Standard
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Half-latch position
4-5
Continuity
Full-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-5
No continuity
(c) Check the back door latch switch continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
latch switch.
Standard
Open-latch
Harf-latch
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-6
Continuity
Half-latch position, Fulllatch position
4-6
No continuity
(d) Check the position switch continuity.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to connector
terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to connector
terminal 2.
Standard
Full-latch
Over-latch
B062719E05
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Any position other than
motor stop position
(Motor in operation)
3-4
Continuity
Motor stop position
(Gear in original
position)
3-4
No continuity
NG
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU
REPLACE WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY
ED
ED–15
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
HOOD
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
WITH SPORT EDITION PACKAGE
HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
HOOD BULGE
HOOD BULGE PLATE
RIVET
ED
NUT
HOOD AIR INTAKE GUIDE
SCREW
RIVET
HOOD INSULATOR
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
HOOD AIR INTAKE GUIDE NO. 1 RETAINER
CLIP
x11
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
HOOD AUXILIARY CATCH
HOOK ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR GRILLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120194E01
ED–16
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
HOOD TO RADIATOR
SUPPORT SEAL
AUXILIARY CATCH RELEASE
LEVER ASSEMBLY
13 (130, 10)
HOOD HINGE ASSEMBLY RH
HOOD SUPPORT
ASSEMBLY RH
HOOD HINGE
ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
HOOD SUPPORT
ASSEMBLY LH
ED
13 (130, 10)
17.5 (180, 13)
HOOD TO FRONT
FENDER SEAL RH
WITHOUT SECURITY SYSTEM
13 (130, 10)
HOOD TO FRONT
FENDER SEAL LH
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
HOOD AUXILIARY
CATCH HOOK
WITH SECURITY SYSTEM
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
HOOD LOCK RELEASE
LEVER PROTECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120195E01
ED–14
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
Back Door Closer does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The back door ECU controls the back door closer. In response to the signals output from the switches in
the back door lock, the back door closer drives the closer motor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block Assembly
2
1F
2
L-O
6
DB1
4
B8 DBR
L
POWER
1
ED
1C
Engine Room Junction L-W
Block Assembly
B7
with Motor Back Door Lock Assembly
(Back Door Lock)
2
5
R-G
6
B9 HALF
2
6
G-Y
7
B9 FULL
1
4
BR-W
8
B9 POS
1
L-B
15
B9 ACT+
2
L-R
14
B9 ACT-
3
B-R
21
B9 LSE
J/B
2
ALT
1
2
B
2
2
B
Battery
B064457E01
ED–15
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK
(a) Check that the back door fully closes (fully locked) when
the door is closed by hand.
NG
IMPROPER FIT OF BACK DOOR, OR A
FOREIGN OBJECT IS STUCK IN BACK
DOOR
OK
2
POWER SOURCE RESET
(a) Disconnect the POWER DOOR 30A fuse and reconnect
it. 10 seconds later, check that the back door closer is
operational.
OK
ED
NORMAL
NG
3
INSPECT WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Check operation of the door lock.
(1) Using a screwdriver, push the latch in order to put
the back door lock in the locked condition (full-latch
position).
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and the
negative (-) lead to terminal 2. Then, check
operation of the latch.
Standard:
The latch turns to the open-latch position
(3) Inspect motor operation when battery voltage is
applied to the terminals.
Standard
Fuel-latch
Open-latch
B065423E01
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) - Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) - Terminal 1
Clockwise (Motor in normal rotation)
Battery positive (+) - Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) - Terminal 2
Counterclockwise (Motor in reverse
rotation)
ED–16
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
(b) Check the back door courtesy switch continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
courtesy switch.
Standard
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Half-latch position
4-5
Continuity
Full-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-5
No continuity
(c) Check the back door latch switch continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals of the
latch switch.
Standard
Open-latch
Harf-latch
ED
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Open-latch position,
Over-latch position
4-6
Continuity
Half-latch position, Fulllatch position
4-6
No continuity
(d) Check the position switch continuity.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to connector
terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to connector
terminal 2.
Standard
Full-latch
Over-latch
B062719E05
Door Lock Latch
Position
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
Any position other than
motor stop position
(Motor in operation)
3-4
Continuity
Motor stop position
(Gear in original
position
3-4
No continuity
OK
NG
REPLACE WITH MOTOR BACK DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY
ED–17
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR CLOSER SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BACK DOOR LOCK - BACK BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B7 back door lock and B9 back door
ECU connectors.
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals of the back
door lock (B7) and back door ECU (B9) connectors.
Standard (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
B7
Back Door Lock
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
- (B7-5) - HALF (B9-6)
- (B7-6) - FULL (B9-7)
- (B7-4) - POS (B9-8)
- (B7-1) - ACT+ (B9-15)
Continuity
- (B7-2) - ACT- (B9-14)
B9
Back Door ECU
- (B7-3) - LSE (B9-21)
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR
ECU
ED
B066168E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD SUPPORT ROD
ED–23
HOOD SUPPORT ROD
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ED
HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY RH
HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH
B120195E02
ED–24
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD SUPPORT ROD
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
1.
B062405
ED
REMOVE HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the hood support from the
hood panel.
HINT:
While supporting the hood by hand, remove the
hood support.
(b) Remove the bolt and hood support from the vehicle
body.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
ED–17
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (See page IP-6).
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and auxiliary catch release
lever.
(b) Remove the bolt and hood auxiliary catch hook.
(c) Remove the 10 nuts and radiator grille.
2.
REMOVE HOOD INSULATOR
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 11 clips and hood
insulator.
3.
REMOVE HOOD BULGE (for Sport Package)
(a) Remove the screw and 5 nuts, as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Remove the hood bulge.
(c) Remove the hood air intake guide No. 1 retainer.
Retainer
ED
Screw
B062402E01
(d) Using a drill of less than φ 4mm (0.16 in.), drill out
the rivet heads and remove the hood bulge.
Dimension (A):
5 mm (0.20 in.)
(e) Gently and vertically put the drill onto the rivet, and
cut the rivet flanges.
(f) Remove the hood bulge plate and air intake guide.
NOTICE:
• Prizing the hole with a drill can lead to
damage to the rivet hole or breaking the drill.
• Be careful with the cut rivet, because it is hot.
(g) Even if the flange is taken off, continue drilling and
push out the remaining fragments using the drill.
(h) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the drilled rivet
and dust from the inside of the hood bulge.
B062403
4.
REMOVE HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH (See page
ED-24)
5.
REMOVE HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY RH (See page
ED-24)
6.
REMOVE HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the windshield washer hose.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and hood.
7.
REMOVE HOOD HINGE ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and hood hinge.
8.
REMOVE HOOD HINGE ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and hood hinge.
ED–18
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
9.
10. REMOVE HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 clips.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the hood lock release lever protector.
NOTICE:
Removing the protector damages the clips
inside the protector, therefore the use of a new
protector is necessary on installation.
Protector
: Clip
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 8 clips and
support seal.
B062406E01
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and hood lock.
(d) with Security system:
Disconnect the connector.
ED
B063509
ED–25
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER LH
FRONT DOOR
OUTSIDE HANDLE
PAD FRONT
FRONT DOOR GLASS RUN LH
FRONT DOOR HANDLE
ASSEMBLY OUTSIDE LH
ED
HOLE PLUG
FRONT DOOR GLASS
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT
DOOR LOCK
OPEN ROD
FRONT DOOR FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR LOWER LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
*
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
DOOR LOCK WIRE
HARNESS PACKING
FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
* Precoated part
B120196E01
ED–26
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
FRONT DOOR GLASS
WEATHERSTRIP INNER LH
FRONT DOOR
INSIDE HANDLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
ED
FRONT DOOR ARMLEST
ASSEMBLY
POWER MIRROR
SWITCH
DOOR INSIDE HANDLE NO. 2
BEZEL LH
DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH
FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
Non-reusable part
B120197E02
ED–27
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
OUTER REAR VIEW
MIRROR ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR WINDOW
FRAME MOULDING REAR LH
FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME
BRACKET GARNISH LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR GLASS
WEATHERSTRIP INNER LH
CUSHION
RUBBER
ED
26 (265, 19)
FRONT DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
CUSHION
RUBBER
SPEAKER MOUNTING
NO. 1 BRACKET
FRONT NO. 2
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
*
30 (306, 22)
DOOR CHECK
26 (265, 19)
Clip
FRONT NO. 1
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
Clip
FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
* Precoated part
B120198E01
ED–19
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
• Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSPECT HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the clearance is within the standard
value.
A
B
ED
B062397E01
Standard clearance
2.
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E24
Area
Measurement
A
3.9 +- 1.5 mm (0.154 +- 0.059 in.)
B
0.4 +- 1.5 mm (0.015 +- 0.059 in.)
ADJUST HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Horizontally adjust the hood.
HINT:
• Centering bolts are used to mount the hood
hinge and hood lock. The hood and hood lock
cannot be adjusted with the centering bolts on.
Substitute the centering bolts with standard bolts
(w/ washers) when making adjustments.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in
the standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
(1) Loosen the hood side hinge bolts.
B062399
ED–20
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
A
(2) Adjust the clearance so that it will be in the
standard value, by moving the hood.
Standard (A):
3.9 +- 1.5 mm (0.154 +- 0.059 in.)
(3) Tighten the hood side hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
Aligned
B062398E01
(b) Adjust the height of the hood front end by the
cushion rubber.
(1) Adjust the cushion rubber so that the hood and
the fender will be aligned.
HINT:
The cushion rubber goes up and down by
turning it.
ED
Cushion
Rubber
B062400E01
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E24
Protector
: Clip
B062406E01
(c) Adjust the hood lock.
HINT:
• Centering bolts are used to mount the hood
hinge and hood lock. The hood and hood lock
cannot be adjusted with the centering bolts on.
Substitute the centering bolts with standard bolts
(w/ washers) when making adjustments.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in
the standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
(1) Using a clip remover, disengage the clips,
remove the 8 radiator support seal upper clips.
(2) Remove the radiator support seal upper.
(3) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 clips.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(4) Remove the hood lock release lever protector.
NOTICE:
Removing the protector damages the clips
inside the protector, therefore the use of a
new protector is necessary on the
installation.
ED–38
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR LOCK W/
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
*
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
DOOR LOCK WIRE HARNESS PACKING
REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
ED
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR GLASS
WEATHERSTRIP INNER LH
DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE NO. 2
BEZEL LH
REAR DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR ARMREST
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR
Non-reusable part
* Precoated part
B120199E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–39
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE PAD FRONT
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER LH
REAR DOOR HANDLE ASSEMBLY OUTSIDE LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING FRONT LH
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD REAR
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
ED
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR
QUARTER WINDOW
WETHERSTRIP LH
REAR DOOR QUARTER
GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN LH
REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW DIVISION BAR SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120200E01
ED–40
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
REAR DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
26 (265, 19)
ED
DOOR CHECK
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
26 (265, 19)
*
36 (306, 22)
26 (265, 19)
CHILD PROTECTOR LOCK HOLE PLUG
REAR DOOR HINGE ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
* Precoated part
B134257E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
ED–21
(5) Adjust the hood lock position so that the striker
will come in, by moving the striker.
(6) Tighten the hood lock bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
B062401
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) with Security system:
Connect the connector.
(b) Install the hood lock assembly with the 3 bolts.
(c) Adjust the hood lock position so that the striker will
come in, by moving the striker (See page ED-18).
(d) Tighten the hood lock bolts after the adjustment.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL HOOD HINGE ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the hood hinge with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 13.0 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL HOOD HINGE ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the hood hinge with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 13.0 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hood with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 13.0 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH (See page
ED-24)
6.
INSTALL HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY RH (See page
ED-24)
7.
INSTALL HOOD BULGE (for Sport Package)
(a) Install the hood bulge plate and hood air intake
guide to the hood bulge.
B063509
B062407
ED
ED–22
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
(b) Using a hand riveter or air riveter with nose piece,
strike rivets into the hood bulge assembly.
NOTICE:
• If the rivet is not positioned perpendicularly,
it will bend the mandrel.
• Do not prize a riveter, because the riveter will
be damaged and the mandrel will be bent.
• Do not tilt the riveter when removing the rivet,
because the materials are not tightened
firmly.
• Install the rivet while attaching the materials,
because they are not tightened firmly.
ED
B127202
(c) Install the hood air intake guide No. 1 retainer with
the screw and hood bulge assembly.
(d) Install the hood bulge assembly to the hood with the
5 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
Retainer
8.
Screw
B062402E01
INSTALL RADIATOR GRILLE
(a) Install the radiator grille with the 12 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the hood auxiliary catch hook with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the auxiliary catch release lever with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
ED–50
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ED
BACK DOOR GLASS RUN
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
W/O REAR SPOILER
STOP CENTER LAMP ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP OUTER
B120201E02
ED–51
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR DAMPER STAY
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
BACK DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY RH
BACK DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY LH
19.5 (200, 14)
WASHER NOZZLE
ASSEMBLY
REAR WIPER ARM AND
BLADE ASSEMBLY
WIPER ARM
HEAD CAP
19.5 (200, 14)
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
19.5 (200, 14)
BACK DOOR
LOCK CYLINDER
17.5 (180, 13)
ED
CUSHION
19.5 (200, 14)
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
LINER WIPER
STEP RH
CUSHION
BACK DOOR
STOPPER LOWER RH
17.5 (180, 13)
BACK DOOR LOWER
STOPPER CUSHION RH
BACK DOOR DUMPER
STAY SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR STOPPER
LOWER LH
TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR LOWER STOPPER CUSHION LH
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120202E03
ED–52
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR GLASS
SUB-ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
ED
COVER PLATE
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR ASSEMBLY
MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR
COMPUTER ASSEMBLY
SERVICE HOLE
COVER LH
BACK DOOR GLASS
WEATHERSTRIP INNER
SERVICE
HOLE COVER
BACK DOOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR TRIM COVER
BACK DOOR LOCK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
ASSIST STRAP ASSEMBLY RH
ASSIST STRAP HOLE COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD
Non-reusable part
B120203E03
ED–25
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD SUPPORT ROD
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the hood support with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (180 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
DISPOSAL
1.
a
A
b
B
B065104E14
DISPOSE OF HOOD SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Horizontally fix the stay in a vise with the piston-rod
pulled out.
(b) Wearing safety glasses, gradually cut a part
between A and B as shown in the illustration using a
metal saw to gradually release the gas.
Specification
Area
Measurement
a
80 mm (3.15 in.)
b
20 mm (0.80 in.)
CAUTION:
Be careful to cover the area that is being cut as
there is a possibility that metal debris could be
blown out by the gas (the gas is colorless,
odorless and harmless).
ED
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
ED–61
BACK DOOR SUPPORT
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ED
BACK DOOR DUMPER
STAY SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
B120202E04
ED–62
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
1.
B063577
ED
REMOVE BACK DOOR DUMPER STAY SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and damper stay from the door
panel.
HINT:
While supporting the hood by hand, remove the
hood support.
(b) Loosen the bolt and remove the damper stay from
the vehicle body.
ED–28
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
1.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the lower frame
bracket garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws, and
remove the inside handle bezel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE FRONT ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disengage the claws, and remove the armrest from
the trim board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 cushion rubbers.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and clips.
(c) Using a clip remover, remove the 11 clips.
(d) Remove the trim board upward.
HINT:
In order to prevent the door from being damaged,
cover the parts indicated by arrow marks in the
illustration with tape.
Clip
: Clip
B062415E01
Claw
ED
Claw
B062416E02
Claw
Claw
: Claw B062417E01
: Claw
B062418E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–29
(e) Disconnect the 2 cables from the inside handle as
shown in the illustration.
(f) Remove the inner weatherstrip.
(g) Remove the 3 screws and power window master
switch.
H006127E01
(h) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(i) Remove the power mirror switch, as shown in the
illustration.
Claw
ED
B064057E01
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the front door service hole cover LH.
NOTICE:
Remove the remaining tape on the door side.
6.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the outer rear view mirror connector.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and outer rear view mirror.
NOTICE:
When the nuts are removed, the outer rear view
mirror might drop and be deformed.
7.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (See
page AV-172)
8.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the speaker connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 speaker.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and speaker mounting No. 1
bracket.
9.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH (See page ET-63)
B065760E01
B062419
B062421
10. REMOVE FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ASSEMBLY OUTER LH (See page ET-27)
ED–30
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
11. REMOVE FRONT DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
HINT:
Insert a shop rag inside the door panel to prevent the
glass from being scratched.
(a) Open the door glass until the bolts appear in the
service holes.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and holding the door glass.
B062422
(c) Remove the door glass, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the door glass.
• When the bolts are removed, the door glass
might drop and be deformed.
(d) Remove the door glass run.
(2)
(1)
ED
B062423E12
B062424
12. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the window regulator connector.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and window regulator.
NOTICE:
When the bolts are removed, the window
regulator might drop and be deformed.
HINT:
Remove the window regulator through the service
hole.
13. REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Place matchmarks on the window regulator motor
gear and regulator gear.
(b) Using a "torx" driver (T25), remove the 3 screws
and window regulator motor.
14. REMOVE FRONT DOOR FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR LOWER LH
(a) Remove the bolt and frame rear lower.
B062425E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–31
15. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
LH
(a) Remove the hole plug.
(b) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), loosen the
screw and remove the outside handle cover with the
door lock key cylinder installed.
Hole Plug
B061438E22
16. REMOVE FRONT DOOR W/MOTOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the door lock connector.
(b) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), remove the 3
screws and door lock.
HINT:
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
(c) Remove the door lock wire harness packing.
ED
B062426
17. REMOVE FRONT DOOR HANDLE ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE LH
(a) Pushing and pulling the outside handle in the arrow
mark direction in the illustration, remove the outside
handle.
(b) Remove the outside handle pad front and rear.
(1)
(2)
B056613E13
18. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), loosen the
screw.
(b) Slide the outside handle frame from to remove it.
HINT:
Remove the outside handle frame through the
service hole.
Bolt
B062427E01
19. REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOCK CHECK ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, bolt and the door check.
20. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
(a) Using a clip remover, disengage the clips and
remove the weatherstrip.
HINT:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
B062429
ED–32
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
21. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WIRE LH
(a) Disconnect the door wire clips.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and door wire.
B062428
ED
ED–33
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
• Before adjusting the door position for vehicles equipped
with side airbags and curtain shield airbags, be sure to
disconnect the battery. After adjustment, inspect the SRS
warning lamp, the side airbag system and the curtain
shield airbag system for normal operation. Then initialize
both systems.
• Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSPECT FRONT DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check that the clearance is within the standard
value.
B
A
E
ED
C
D
B062408E01
Standard clearance
2.
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E01
Area
Measurement
A
4.5 +- 1.5 mm (0.177 +- 0.059 in.)
B
5.6 +- 1.5 mm (0.220 +- 0.059 in.)
C
7.6 +- 1.5 mm (0.299 +- 0.059 in.)
D
5.0 +- 1.5 mm (0.197 +- 0.059 in.)
E
160 mm (6.30 in.)
ADJUST FRONT DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Adjust the front door panel position.
HINT:
• Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge
to the vehicle body and door. The door cannot be
adjusted with the centering bolts on. Substitute
the centering bolts with standard bolts (w/
washers) when making adjustments.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in
the standard bolt chart (See page IP-6).
ED–34
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
(1) Put protective tape on the door panel and
fender, as shown in the illustration.
Protective Tape
B064377E01
Clip
Protector
ED
B064378E01
(2) Open the door, and remove the 5 clips.
NOTICE:
If the clips are damaged, replace them with
new ones.
(3) Remove the gap between the front fender side
panel protector LH from the gap between the
fender and door.
HINT:
If the clips are damaged, replace them with
new ones.
(4) Using SST, horizontally and vertically adjust the
door by loosening the body side hinge bolts.
SST 09812-00010, 09812-00020
(5) Tighten the body side hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
B062409
(6) Adjust the door by loosening the door side
hinge bolts forward/ rearward and vertically.
(7) Tighten the door side hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
(8) Install the front fender side panel protector LH
with the 5 clips.
B062410
B062411
(9) Adjust the striker position by slightly loosening
the striker mounting screws and hitting the
striker with a plastic-faced hammer.
(10) Tighten the striker mounting screws after the
adjustment.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
(11) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable from
the battery.
(12) Initialize both systems.
(13) Check the SRS warning lamp.
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
ET–3
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 3 clips.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and 9 screws.
(c) with Fog light:
(1) Disconnect the fog light assembly connectors.
B120252
(d) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 8 claws and
remove the front bumper assembly.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B120253
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER LH (w/o
Fog Light)
(a) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the front
bumper hole cover LH.
2.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER RH (w/o
Fog Light)
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
3.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER LH (w/ Fog
Light) (See page LI-47)
4.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER RH (w/ Fog
Light)
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120254
ET
ET–4
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
5.
REMOVE FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY LH (w/ Fog Light)
(See page LI-37)
6.
REMOVE FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY RH (w/ Fog Light)
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
7.
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE LOWER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Disengage the 13 claws and remove the radiator
grille lower.
8.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER
9.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
PLATE
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and front bumper reinforcement
plate.
B120255
ET
B120256
10. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET LH
(a) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and front bumper side
mounting bracket LH.
11. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120257
12. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 screws and front
bumper side support LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
13. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120258
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
ET–5
14. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
(a) Remove the front bumper energy absorber.
B120259
15. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and front bumper reinforcement
sub-assembly.
B120260
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front bumper reinforcement sub-assembly
with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 58 N*m (591 kgf*cm, 43 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
3.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT LH
(a) Install the front bumper side support LH with the 2
screws.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
5.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET LH
(a) Install the front bumper side mounting bracket LH
with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: Bolt
8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
Nut
5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
B120260
B120258
B120257
ET
ET–6
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
6.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
7.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT PLATE
(a) Install the front bumper reinforcement plate with the
3 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER
(a) Install the radiator grille lower with the 13 claws.
(b) Install the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (77 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL RADIATOR GRILLE LOWER
B120256
10. INSTALL FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY LH (See page LI-50)
ET
B120255
11. INSTALL FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
12. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER LH (w/o
Fog Light) (See page LI-51)
13. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER RH (w/o
Fog Light)
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
14. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER LH (w/ Fog
Light)
15. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER RH (w/ Fog
Light)
INSTALLATION
1.
B120253
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front bumper assembly with the 8 claws.
(b) with Fog light:
(1) Connect the fog light assembly connectors.
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
ET–7
(c) Install the 4 bolts and 9 screws.
Torque: Bolt
8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
Screw
3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the 3 clips.
Screw
Screw
Bolt
B120252E02
2.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
3.
VEHICLE FOR FOG LIGHT AIMING ADJUSTMENT
4.
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR FOG LIGHT AIM
ADJUSTMENT
5.
INSPECT FOG LIGHT AIMING
LI-47
6.
ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIMING
LI-47
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
Some systems need initialization when disconnecting
the cable from the negative battery terminal.
ET
ET–10
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER STEP CUSHION
REAR BUMPER PROTECTOR RH
REAR BUMPER PROTECTOR LH
REAR BUMPER COVER
ET
Non-reusable part
B120289E01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
(b) Remove the 7 screws and quarter panel mudguard
sub-assembly rear LH.
2.
REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
3.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
(b) Remove the 8 bolts and 4 screws.
B120261
B120262
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
ET–11
(c) Disengage the 6 claws and remove the rear bumper
assembly.
B120263
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER STEP CUSHION
(a) Remove the 6 rear bumper stop cushions.
ET
B120264
2.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER PROTECTOR LH
(a) Remove the rear bumper protector LH.
3.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER PROTECTOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
4.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER COVER
5.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER RETAINER UPPER LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and
remove the rear bumper retainer upper LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER RETAINER UPPER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120265
B120266
ET–12
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
7.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER END RETAINER LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and
remove the rear bumper end retainer LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER END RETAINER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
9.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER BAR REINFORCEMENT LH
(a) Remove the screw and rear bumper bar
reinforcement LH.
B120267
10. REMOVE REAR BUMPER BAR REINFORCEMENT
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120268
ET
11. REMOVE REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
(a) Remove the rear bumper energy absorber.
B120269
12. REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET LH
(a) Remove the bolt and rear bumper side mounting
bracket LH.
13. REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120270
14. REMOVE REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT NO. 2
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 2 rear bumper
reinforcement.
15. REMOVE REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT NO. 1
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120271
ET–1
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING BRACKET LH
FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT RH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT PLATE
ET
58 (591, 43)
58 (591, 43)
FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT LH
FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT SUB-ASSEMBLY
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
B120174E01
ET–2
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER COVER
7.5 (77, 66 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR GRILLE LOWER
ET
without Fog Light:
without Fog Light:
FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER RH
with Fog Light:
FOG LIGHT
ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER RH
FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER LH
with Fog Light:
FOG LIGHT
ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120288E01
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
ET–13
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT NO. 2
(a) Install the No. 2 rear bumper reinforcement with the
bolt.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT NO. 1
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
3.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET LH
(a) Install the rear bumper side mounting bracket LH
with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
5.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
6.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER BAR REINFORCEMENT LH
(a) Install the rear bumper bar reinforcement LH with
the screw.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER BAR REINFORCEMENT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
8.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER END RETAINER LH
(a) Install the rear bumper end retainer LH with the
screw and claw.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER END RETAINER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120271
B120270
B120268
B120267
10. INSTALL REAR BUMPER RETAINER UPPER LH
(a) Install the rear bumper retainer upper LH with the 2
screws and claw.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
11. INSTALL REAR BUMPER RETAINER UPPER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
12. INSTALL REAR BUMPER COVER
B120266
ET
ET–14
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
13. INSTALL REAR BUMPER PROTECTOR LH
(a) Install a new rear bumper protector LH.
14. INSTALL REAR BUMPER PROTECTOR RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
B120265
15. INSTALL REAR BUMPER STEP CUSHION
(a) Install 6 new rear bumper stop cushions.
B120264
ET
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear bumper assembly with the 6 claws.
B120263
(b) Install the 8 bolts and 4 screws.
Torque: Bolt
8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
Screw
5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the 2 clips.
Bolt
Screw
Bolt
Screw
B120262E01
2.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
3.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR RH
ET–8
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR BUMPER
RETAINER UPPER RH
ET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER
END RETAINER RH
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER
END RETAINER LH
REAR BUMPER
RETAINER UPPER LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER SIDE
MOUNTING BRACKET RH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER SIDE
MOUNTING BRACKET LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120175E01
ET–9
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
REINFORCEMENT
NO. 1
REAR BUMPER
ENERGY ABSORBER
REAR BUMPER
REINFORCEMENT
NO. 2
25 (255, 18)
25 (255, 18)
QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR LH
QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR RH
REAR BUMPER BAR
REINFORCEMENT RH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER BAR
REINFORCEMENT LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B134260E01
ET
EXTERIOR – ROOF RACK
ET–23
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ROOF RACK BAR JOINT NO. 2
(a) Using a torx wrench (T25), install the 8 screws to
the roof rack bar joint.
2.
INSTALL ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT LH
(a) Install the rack leg with the 2 screws.
3.
INSTALL ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT RH
(a) Install the rack leg with the 2 screws.
4.
INSTALL ROOF RACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a white gasoline, clean the bolt and thread.
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or
equivalent
Adhesive
B064237E01
(c) Install the roof rack assembly with the 8 bolts.
B063613
5.
INSTALL ROOF RACK LEG COVER REAR LH
(a) Install the leg cover with the 4 claws and clip.
6.
INSTALL ROOF RACK LEG COVER REAR RH
(a) Install the leg cover with the 4 claws and clip.
7.
INSTALL ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT LH
(a) Install the leg cover with the 4 claws and clip.
8.
INSTALL ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT RH
(a) Install the leg cover with the 4 claws and clip.
B063612
B063611
ET
ET–15
EXTERIOR – NAME PLATE
NAME PLATE
REPLACEMENT
1.
REPLACE NAME PLATE
Front Fender Emblem (Left, Right)
Back Door Name Plate
Front Fender Emblem (Left)
309.0 (12.165)
Front Fender Emblem (Right)
309.0 (12.165)
83.0 (3.268)
83.0 (3.268)
302.0
(11.890)
306.5 (12.067)
167.5 (6.594)
167.5 (6.594)
83.0 (3.268)
302.0
(11.890)
302.0
(11.890)
306.5 (12.067)
83.0 (3.268)
304.0 (11.968)
304.0 (11.968)
302.0
(11.890)
mm (in.)
B134208E01
ET
ET–16
EXTERIOR – NAME PLATE
Front Fender Emblem (Left)
Front Fender Emblem (Right)
262.0 (10.315)
262.0 (10.315)
83.0 (3.268)
302.0
(11.890)
83.0 (3.268)
304.0 (11.968)
315.0 (12.401)
ET
6.0 (0.236)
83.0 (3.268)
304.0 (11.968)
408.0 (16.063)
6.0 (0.236)
302.0
(11.890)
307.0 (12.087)
288.0 (11.339)
26.0 (1.024)
302.0
(11.890)
308.5 (12.146)
176.0 (6.923)
304.0
(11.968)
381.0 (14.000)
176.0 (6.923)
83.0 (3.268)
26.0 (1.024)
302.0
(11.890)
306.5 (12.067)
308.5 (12.146)
304.0
(11.968)
mm (in.)
B134209E01
ET–17
EXTERIOR – NAME PLATE
Front Fender Emblem (Left)
193.5 (7.618)
Front Fender Emblem (Right)
26.0 (1.024)
286.5 (11.280)
83.0 (3.268)
176.0 (6.92)
26.0 (1.024)
302.0 (11.890)
304.5 (11.988)
306.5 (12.067)
304.0 (11.968)
Back Door Name Plate
171.5 (6.752)
ET
142.0 (5.591)
48.0 (1.890)
226.5 (8.917)
131.0 (5.157)
34.0 (1.339)
B134210E01
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ET–27
REMOVAL
HINT:
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
Screw
Protective Tape
Tape
B062951E01
1.
REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-28)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-28)
4.
REMOVE FRONT ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH (See
page ED-28)
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-28)
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(See page ED-29)
7.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH (See page ED-29)
8.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH (See page ET-63)
9.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ASSEMBLY OUTER LH
(a) Put protective tape under the glass weatherstrip
assembly.
(b) Remove the screw.
(c) Using a screwdriver or moulding remover,
disengage the claw and remove the glass
weatherstrip.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
ET
ET–28
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
INSTALLATION
ET
1.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ASSEMBLY OUTER LH
(a) Install the glass weatherstrip with the claw and
screw.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH
3.
INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH (See page ED-37)
4.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(See page ED-37)
5.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
6.
INSTALL FRONT ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
8.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
9.
INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
ET–18
EXTERIOR – REAR SPOILER
REAR SPOILER
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SPOILER CLIP NO. 1
2.5 (25, 22 in.*lbf)
REAR SPOILER
REAR SPOILER CLIP NO. 1
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
ET
CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120176E01
EXTERIOR – REAR SPOILER
ET–19
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER
(a) Remove the 2 grommets, 2 bolts and spoiler.
(b) Disconnect the center stop light connector.
2.
REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and stop light assembly.
3.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER CLIP NO. 1
(a) Use a drill which tip is less than φ 4 mm (0.16 in.).
(b) Tape the drill tip as shown in the illustration.
Dimension (A):
5 mm (0.20 in.)
HINT:
In order not to drill too deeply, tape the drill tip.
(c) Gently and vertically place the drill tip onto the rivet,
cut the rivet flanges, and then remove the rivet.
NOTICE:
• Placing the drill tip strongly will turn the rivet
together with the drill, and so the rivet will not
be cut.
• Prizing the hole with a drill can lead to
damage to the rivet hole or the drill itself.
• Be careful in undertaking this task as the cut
rivet is hot.
(d) Remove the 2 spoiler clips from the back door
panel.
B063789
B063787
A
B064660E01
INSTALLATION
1.
B064661
INSTALL REAR SPOILER CLIP NO. 1
(a) Using an air riveter or hand riveter with nose piece,
strike waterproof rivets of φ 4 mm into the body
panel to install the 2 rear spoiler clips No. 1 to the
back door panel.
NOTICE:
If the rivet is not positioned perpendicularly, it
will bend the mandrel.
ET
ET–20
EXTERIOR – REAR SPOILER
2.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the stop light assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 2.5 N*m (25 kgf*cm, 22 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER
(a) Connect the center stop light connector.
(b) Install the spoiler with the 2 bolts and 2 grommets.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
B063787
B063789
ET
ET–32
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
HINT:
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
ET
Screw
Protective Tape
Tape
B062582E01
1.
REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY REAR
2.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-41)
3.
REMOVE REAR ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH (See page
ED-41)
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-41)
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
FRONT LH (See page ET-66)
6.
REMOVE REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
OUTER
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Put protective tape under the glass weatherstrip.
(c) Using a screwdriver or moulding remover,
disengage the claw and remove glass weatherstrip.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ET–33
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
OUTER
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
FRONT LH
3.
INSTALL REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
4.
INSTALL REAR ARMREST ASSEMBLY LH
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
6.
INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY REAR
(a) Install the glass weatherstrip with the claw and
screw.
ET
ET–21
EXTERIOR – ROOF RACK
ROOF RACK
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ROOF RACK LEG
COVER FRONT RH
ROOF CARRIER
BAR RH
REAR ROOF RACK LEG LH
ROOF RACK LEG
COVER REAR RH
ROOF RACK
BRACKET
REAR ROOF RACK LEG RH
ROOF RACK BRACKET
FRONT ROOF RACK LEG LH
ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT LH
ROOF RACK BRACKET
ROOF CARRIER BAR LH
FRONT ROOF RACK LEG RH
ROOF RACK LEG
COVER REAR LH
ROOF RACK BRACKET
ROOF RACK PLATE
ET
REAR ROOF RACK BAR NO. 2
ROOF CARRIER CAP
ROOF RACK BAR JOINT NO. 2
FRONT ROOF RACK BAR
B134207E01
ET–22
EXTERIOR – ROOF RACK
REMOVAL
HINT:
A bolt without torque specification is a standard bolt (See
page SS-1).
1.
REMOVE ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and clip,
and remove the leg cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and clip,
and remove the leg cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE ROOF RACK LEG COVER REAR LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and clip,
and remove the leg cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE ROOF RACK LEG COVER REAR RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and clip,
and remove the leg cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE ROOF RACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the roof rack assembly.
6.
REMOVE ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and rack leg.
7.
REMOVE ROOF RACK LEG COVER FRONT RH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and rack leg.
8.
REMOVE ROOF RACK BAR JOINT NO. 2
(a) Using a torx wrench (T25), remove the 8 screws the
roof rack bar joint.
B063611
ET
B063612
B063613
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ET–35
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the assist strap hole cover.
(b) Remove the assist strap assembly RH.
(c) Remove the back door trim panel.
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ASSEMBLY OUTER
(a) Put protective tape under the glass weatherstrip.
(b) Using a screwdriver or moulding remover,
disengage the claw and remove the glass
weatherstrip outer.
HINT:
• Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
• Put the screwdriver on either edge of the door
glass weatherstrip.
Protective Tape
Tape
ET
B062583E01
ET–36
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
INSTALLATION
ET
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ASSEMBLY OUTER
(a) Install the glass weatherstrip outer with the claw.
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSEMBLY
ET–24
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD FRONT
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE COVER LH
FRONT DOOR GLASS RUN LH
FRONT DOOR HANDLE
ASSEMBLY OUTSIDE LH
ET
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD REAR
HOLE PLUG
FRONT
DOOR LOCK
OPEN ROD
FRONT DOOR GLASS
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR WITH MOTOR
LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
DOOR LOCK WIRE HARNESS PACKING
FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
B120196E03
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ET–25
FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP INNER LH
FRONT ARMREST
ASSEMBLY LH
ET
POWER MIRROR SWITCH
DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
NO. 2 BEZEL LH
DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
B120197E07
ET–26
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING REAR LH
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME
BRACKET GARNISH LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR GLASS
WEATHERSTRIP INNER LH
CUSHION
RUBBER
26 (265, 19)
ET
FRONT DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
CUSHION
RUBBER
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
DOOR CHECK
FRONT NO. 2
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
SPEAKER
MOUNTING NO. 1
BRACKET
30 (306, 22)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
26 (265, 19)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
FRONT NO. 1
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
CLIP
CLIP
FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B120198E03
ET–38
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
REMOVAL
HINT:
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
without Roof Rack
1.
REMOVE ROOF RACK ASSEMBLY LH (w/ Roof
Rack)
HINT:
(See page ET-22)
2.
REMOVE ROOF DRIP SIDE MOULDING COVER
FRONT LH (w/o Roof Rack)
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and
remove the moulding cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE LH
(a) Put protective tape around the windshield moulding.
(b) Pull out the windshield moulding by hand.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the windshield
moulding.
• If the windshield moulding is damaged,
exchange it for a new one.
4.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
FASTENER NO. 1
(a) Put protective tape around the fastener.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 clips and pull
out the fastener by hand.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the windshield and
fastener.
• If the windshield and fastener are damaged,
exchange them for a new one.
Claw
B062586E01
ET
Protective Tape
B062955E01
Protective Tape
B062959E01
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
ET–39
5.
REMOVE ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
CENTER NO. 2 LH
(a) Put protective tape around the moulding.
(b) Pull out the moulding by hand.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the moulding.
6.
REMOVE ROOF DRIP SIDE MOULDING END COVER
REAR LH (w/o Roof Rack)
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and
remove the moulding end cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING REAR
LH
(a) Put protective tape around the moulding.
(b) Pull out the moulding by hand.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the moulding.
• Do not remove the clips.
• In case that the clips are damaged or
removed accidentally, exchange them into
supplied ones.
8.
REMOVE ROOF RACK BRACKET FRONT LH (w/o
Roof Rack)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and bracket.
9.
REMOVE ROOF RACK BRACKET NO. 1 REAR LH (w/
o Roof Rack)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and bracket.
Protective Tape
B062957E01
Claw
B062586E02
Protective Tape
Clip
B062958E01
B062588
ET
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ET–29
REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR LOCK WITH
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
DOOR LOCK WIRE HARNESS PACKING
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
INNER LH
REAR DOOR SERVICE
HOLE COVER LH
DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE NO. 2
BEZEL LH
REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR ARMREST ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR
Precoated part
B120199E03
ET
ET–30
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD FRONT
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE COVER LH
REAR DOOR HANDLE
ASSEMBLY OUTSIDE LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING FRONT LH
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD REAR
ET
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR QUARTER
WINDOW WEATHERSTRIP LH
REAR DOOR
GLASS SUBASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR QUARTER GLASS
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW DIVISION
BAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120200E02
ET–31
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
26 (265, 19)
DOOR CHECK
REAR DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
26 (265, 19)
30 (306, 22)
26 (265, 19)
CHILD PROTECTOR
LOCK HOLE PLUG
REAR DOOR HINGE ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B134257E02
ET
ET–40
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
INSTALLATION
Primer M
1.
Primer M
A
B065596E01
INSTALL ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING CLIP
NO. 1
(a) Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the body on
the vehicle side with Primer M.
Dimension (A):
40 mm (3.125 in.)
NOTICE:
• Dry the primer coating for 3 minutes or more.
• Do not coat the adhesive with Primer M.
• Do not keep any of the opened Primer M for
later use.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding.
Heating temperature:
Body
40 to 60 °C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30 °C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the moulding and body
excessively.
ET
Alignment mark
A
A
A-A
Clip
2.5 mm (0.098 in.)
Clip
Adhesive tape
B063875E01
(b) Apply new adhesive tape to the clip as shown in the
illustration.
(1) Attach the clip to the protrusion on the vehicle
body with adhesive tape.
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
ET–41
2.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE LH
(a) Install the moulding as shown in the illustration.
(1) Install the middle of the moulding onto the front
edge of the roof.
(2) Install the rear end of the moulding along the
side edge of the roof.
(3) Install the front end of the moulding along the
side edge of the windshield.
3.
INSTALL ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
CENTER NO. 2 LH
(a) Install the moulding as shown in the illustration.
(1) Aligning the front end of the moulding with the
alignment mark on the body, install the
moulding.
4.
INSTALL ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING REAR
LH
(a) Install the moulding as shown in the illustration.
2
1
3
Push
Front Edge Of Roof
B063877E01
Alignment mark
Moulding
B063874E01
Moulding
Clip
B063873E01
ET
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
ET–33
BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR GLASS RUN
ET
WITHOUT REAR SPOILER
STOP CENTER LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP ASSEMBLY OUTER
B120201E03
ET–34
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GLASS WEATHERSTRIP
REAR WIPER ARM AND
BLADE ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY RH
BACK DOOR
DAMPER STAY
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
BACK DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY LH
19.5 (200, 14)
WASHER NOZZLE
ASSEMBLY
WIPER ARM
HEAD CAP
19.5 (200, 14)
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR LOCK
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
19.5 (200, 14)
17.5 (180, 13)
19.5 (200, 14)
CUSHION
ET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
LINER
WIPER
STEP RH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
CUSHION
BACK DOOR STOPPER
LOWER RH
17.5 (180, 13)
BACK DOOR LOWER
STOPPER CUSHION RH
BACK DOOR DUMPER
STAY SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
BACK DOOR STOPPER
LOWER LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR LOWER STOPPER CUSHION LH
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120202E05
ET–36
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
WITHOUT ROOF RACK
ROOF DRIP SIDE MOULDING
END COVER REAR LH
ROOF RACK BRACKET
NO. 1 REAR LH
ROOF DRIP SIDE MOULDING
COVER FRONT LH
10 (102, 7.4)
ROOF RACK
BRACKET FRONT LH
ET
WINDSHIELD MOULDING
OUTSIDE LH
RETAINER
BRACKET
RETAINER
BRACKET
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH
MOULDING CLIP NO. 1
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH
MOULDING CENTER NO. 2 LH
WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE
FASTENER NO. 1
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH
MOULDING REAR LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B134211E01
ET–37
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
WITH ROOF RACK
REAR ROOF RACK COVER
ROOF RACK ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT ROOF RACK COVER
31 (316, 22)
WINDSHIELD MOULDING
OUTSIDE LH
ET
RETAINER
BRACKET
RETAINER
BRACKET
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH
MOULDING CLIP NO. 1
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH
MOULDING CENTER NO. 2 LH
WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE
FASTENER NO. 1
REAR ROOF DRIP SIDE
FINISH MOULDING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B134212E01
ET–48
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the front door outside moulding
assembly, heat the vehicle body and front door outside
moulding assembly using a heat light.
Heating temperature:
Item
Temperature
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding
excessively.
(a) Remove the nut.
ET
B120273
(b) Using a heat light, heat the front door outside
moulding sub-assembly.
(c) Using a knife, cut the double-sided tape.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the moulding, be careful not to
damage the moulding.
• Do not damage the body.
(d) Disengage the 11 clips and remove the front door
outside moulding sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
Double-sided Tape
B120274E01
2.
REMOVE NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 2 No. 3 outside moulding clips.
3.
REMOVE NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 9 No. 4 outside moulding clips.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
UPPER
(a) Remove the front door outside moulding pad upper.
ET–49
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
5.
REMOVE NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING RETAINER
(a) Put a 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) drill bit into a drill.
(b) Tape the 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) drill bit without covering
the portion that is 5.0 mm (0.20 in.) from the tip.
HINT:
Tape the 4.0mm (0.16 in.) drill bit to prevent the drill
bit from going too deep.
(c) Lightly press the drill against the rivets, drill off the
flanges of the rivets, and remove the 3 rivets.
NOTICE:
• Pressing the drill too firmly will cause the
rivet to turn and result in the rivet not being
drilled through.
• Do not pry the rivets with the drill, because
this may cause damage to the installation
holes of the rivets or the drill bit.
• Be careful of the drilled rivets as they may
become hot.
(d) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the rivet fragments
and shavings from the drilled areas.
(e) Remove the No. 3 outside moulding retainer from
the front door outside moulding.
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
7.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the rear door outside moulding
assembly, heat the vehicle body and rear door outside
moulding assembly using a heat light.
Heating temperature:
5.0 mm
(0.20 in.)
B120275E01
Item
Temperature
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding
excessively.
ET
ET–50
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
(a) Put a 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) drill bit into a drill.
(b) Tape the 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) drill bit without covering
the portion that is 5.0 mm (0.20 in.) from the tip.
HINT:
Tape the 4.0mm (0.16 in.) drill bit to prevent the drill
bit from going too deep.
(c) Lightly press the drill against the rivets, drill off the
flanges of the rivets, and remove the 3 rivets.
NOTICE:
• Pressing the drill too firmly will cause the
rivet to turn and result in the rivet not being
drilled through.
• Do not pry the rivets with the drill, because
this may cause damage to the installation
holes of the rivets or the drill bit.
• Be careful of the drilled rivets as they may
become hot.
(d) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the rivet fragments
and shavings from the drilled areas.
5.0 mm
(0.20 in.)
B120276E01
ET
(e) Using a heat light, heat the rear door outside
moulding sub-assembly.
(f) Using a knife, cut the double-sided tape.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the moulding, be careful not to
damage the moulding.
• Do not damage the body.
(g) Disengage the 10 clips and remove the rear door
outside moulding sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
Double-sided Tape
B120277E01
8.
REMOVE NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 4 No. 3 outside moulding clips.
9.
REMOVE NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 6 No. 4 outside moulding clips.
10. REMOVE WHEEL HOUSE SEAL FRONT
(a) Remove the wheel house seal front.
11. REMOVE NO. 1 BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
(a) Remove the No. 1 body outside moulding pad.
12. REMOVE NO. 1 REAR DOOR MOULDING PAD
(a) Remove the No. 1 rear door moulding pad.
13. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
UPPER
(a) Remove the rear door outside moulding pad upper.
ET–51
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
5.0 mm
(0.20 in.)
B120278E01
14. REMOVE NO. 5 OUTSIDE MOULDING RETAINER
(a) Put a 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) drill bit into a drill.
(b) Tape the 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) drill bit without covering
the portion that is 5.0 mm (0.20 in.) from the tip.
HINT:
Tape the 4.0mm (0.16 in.) drill bit to prevent the drill
bit from going too deep.
(c) Lightly press the drill against the rivets, drill off the
flanges of the rivets, and remove the 6 rivets.
NOTICE:
• Pressing the drill too firmly will cause the
rivet to turn and result in the rivet not being
drilled through.
• Do not pry the rivets with the drill, because
this may cause damage to the installation
holes of the rivets or the drill bit.
• Be careful of the drilled rivets as they may
become hot.
(d) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the rivet fragments
and shavings from the drilled areas.
(e) Remove the No. 5 outside moulding retainer from
the rear door outside moulding.
15. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
16. REMOVE FRONT BODY MUDGUARD
(a) Remove the 4 screws, 3 clips and front body
mudguard.
17. REMOVE STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts.
(b) with Step light:
Disconnect the step light wiring connector.
(c) Remove the step sub-assembly.
18. REMOVE ROCKER PANEL MOULDING SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the rocker panel moulding sub-assembly,
heat the vehicle body and rocker panel moulding subassembly using a heat light.
Heating temperature:
Item
Temperature
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding
excessively.
(a) Remove the 2 screws and 4 clips.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the rocker panel moulding
sub-assembly.
(c) Using a knife, cut the double-sided tape.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the moulding, be careful not to
damage the moulding.
• Do not damage the body.
ET
ET–52
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
(d) Disengage the 8 clips and remove the rocker panel
moulding sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
Double-sided Tape
B120279E01
ET
19. REMOVE NO. 1 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 3 No. 1 outside moulding clips.
20. REMOVE NO. 2 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 5 No. 2 outside moulding clips.
21. REMOVE NO. 1 ROCKER PANEL MOULDING
PROTECTOR
(a) Remove the No. 1 rocker panel moulding protector.
22. REMOVE ROCKER PANEL MOULDING FRONT
23. REMOVE DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
24. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
HINT:
(See page ET-3)
25. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
HINT:
(See page ET-3)
26. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL OPENING EXTENSION
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disengage the 12 clips and remove the front wheel
opening extension sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
B120280
27. REMOVE NO. 1 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 3 No. 1 outside moulding clips.
28. REMOVE NO. 2 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 9 No. 2 outside moulding clips.
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
ET–53
29. REMOVE FRONT FENDER OUTSIDE MOULDING
PAD
(a) Remove the front fender outside moulding pad.
30. REMOVE BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
(a) Remove the body outside moulding pad.
31. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL OPENING OR ARCH
MOULDING EXTENSION
32. REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH (See page ET-10)
33. REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR RH (See page ET-10)
34. REMOVE REAR BUMPER ASSEMBLY (See page ET10)
35. REMOVE REAR QUARTER OUTSIDE MOULDING
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disengage the 5 clips and remove the rear quarter
outside moulding sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
If the clips are damaged, exchange them for new
clips.
B120281
36. REMOVE NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 2 No. 3 outside moulding clips.
37. REMOVE NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Remove the 3 No. 4 outside moulding clips.
38. REMOVE NO. 1 QUARTER PANEL MOULDING PAD
(a) Remove the No. 1 quarter panel moulding pad.
39. REMOVE REAR QUARTER OUTSIDE MOULDING
ET
ET–54
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
INSTALLATION
B120281
ET
1.
INSTALL REAR QUARTER OUTSIDE MOULDING
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 QUARTER PANEL MOULDING PAD
(a) Install a new No. 1 quarter panel moulding pad.
3.
INSTALL NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
4.
INSTALL NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
5.
INSTALL REAR QUARTER OUTSIDE MOULDING
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear quarter outside moulding subassembly with the 5 clips.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER ASSEMBLY (See page ET14)
7.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR RH
8.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUBASSEMBLY REAR LH
9.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL OPENING OR ARCH
MOULDING EXTENSION
10. INSTALL BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
(a) Install a new body outside moulding pad.
11. INSTALL FRONT FENDER OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
(a) Install a new front fender outside moulding pad.
12. INSTALL NO. 2 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
13. INSTALL NO. 1 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
14. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL OPENING EXTENSION
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front wheel opening extension subassembly with the 12 clips.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
15. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
HINT:
(See page ET-6)
B120280
16. INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
(See page ET-6)
17. INSTALL CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
18. VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR FOG LIGHT AIM
19. PREPARATION FOR FOG LIGHT AIMING
20. INSPECT FOG LIGHT AIMING
21. ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIMING
ET–55
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
22. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
Some systems need initialization when disconnecting
the cable from the negative battery terminal.
23. INSTALL ROCKER PANEL MOULDING FRONT
24. INSTALL NO. 1 ROCKER PANEL MOULDING
PROTECTOR
(a) Install a new No. 1 rocker panel moulding protector.
25. INSTALL NO. 2 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
26. INSTALL NO. 1 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
27. INSTALL ROCKER PANEL MOULDING SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the rocker panel moulding sub-assembly,
heat the vehicle body and rocker panel moulding subassembly using a heat light.
Heating temperature:
Item
Temperature
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding
excessively.
(a) Clean the vehicle body surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body
surface.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the vehicle
body.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with
cleaner.
(b) Clean the rocker panel moulding sub-assembly. (If
reusing the rocker panel moulding sub-assembly.)
(1) Using a heat light, heat the rocker panel
moulding sub-assembly.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the rocker
panel moulding sub-assembly.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with
cleaner.
(4) Apply new double-sided tape to the rocker
panel moulding sub-assembly.
(c) Install the rocker panel moulding sub-assembly.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body and
rocker panel moulding sub-assembly.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
rocker panel moulding sub-assembly.
HINT:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
(3) Install the rocker panel moulding sub-assembly
with the 8 clips.
(4) Install the 2 screws and 4 clips.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
ET
ET–56
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
Double-sided Tape
B120279E01
ET
28. INSTALL STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) with Step light:
Connect the step light wiring connector.
(b) Install the step sub-assembly with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
29. INSTALL FRONT BODY MUDGUARD
30. INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
ET–57
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
31. INSTALL NO. 5 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
(a) Using an air riveter or hand riveter with a nose
piece, install the No. 5 outside moulding retainer
with 6 new rivets.
HINT:
If the rivet cannot be cut, pull it again and cut it.
NOTICE:
• Do not pry the rivet with the riveter, as this
will cause damage to the riveter and mandrel.
• Confirm that the rivets are seated properly
against the moulding. Do not tilt the riveter
when installing the rivet to the moulding. Do
not leave any space between the rivet head
and moulding.
• Do not leave any space between the moulding
and door frame. Firmly hold together the 2
items while installing the rivet.
32. INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
UPPER
(a) Install a new rear door outside moulding pad upper.
INCORRECT
Riveter
33. INSTALL NO. 1 REAR DOOR MOULDING PAD
(a) Install a new No. 1 rear door moulding pad.
34. INSTALL NO. 1 OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
(a) Install a new No. 1 body outside moulding pad.
35. INSTALL WHEEL HOUSE SEAL FRONT
(a) Install a new wheel house seal front.
36. INSTALL NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
37. INSTALL NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
Mandrel
INCORRECT
Riveter
INCORRECT
Riveter
INCORRECT
Riveter
B146493E01
38. INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the rear door outside moulding
assembly, heat the vehicle body and rear door outside
moulding assembly using a heat light.
Heating temperature:
Item
Temperature
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding
excessively.
(a) Clean the vehicle body surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body
surface.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the vehicle
body.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with
cleaner.
ET
ET–58
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
(b) Clean the rear door outside moulding sub-assembly.
(If reusing the rear door outside moulding subassembly.)
(1) Using a heat light, heat the rear door outside
moulding sub-assembly.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the rear
door outside moulding sub-assembly.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with
cleaner.
(4) Apply new double-sided tape to the rear door
outside moulding sub-assembly.
Double-sided Tape
B120277E01
ET
(c) Install the rear door outside moulding sub-assembly.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body and
rear door outside moulding sub-assembly.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
rear door outside moulding sub-assembly.
HINT:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
(3) Install the rear door outside moulding subassembly with the 10 clips.
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
ET–59
(4) Using an air riveter or hand riveter with a nose
piece, install 3 new rivets.
HINT:
If the rivet cannot be cut, pull it again and cut it.
NOTICE:
• Do not pry the rivet with the riveter, as
this will cause damage to the riveter and
mandrel.
• Confirm that the rivets are seated
properly against the moulding. Do not tilt
the riveter when installing the rivet to the
moulding. Do not leave any space
between the rivet head and moulding.
• Do not leave any space between the
moulding and door frame. Firmly hold
together the 2 items while installing the
rivet.
39. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
INCORRECT
Riveter
Mandrel
INCORRECT
Riveter
INCORRECT
Riveter
INCORRECT
Riveter
B146494E01
ET
ET–60
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
40. INSTALL NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING RETAINER
(a) Using an air riveter or hand riveter with a nose
piece, install the No. 3 outside moulding retainer
with 3 new rivets.
HINT:
If the rivet cannot be cut, pull it again and cut it.
NOTICE:
• Do not pry the rivet with the riveter, as this
will cause damage to the riveter and mandrel.
• Confirm that the rivets are seated properly
against the moulding. Do not tilt the riveter
when installing the rivet to the moulding. Do
not leave any space between the rivet head
and moulding.
• Do not leave any space between the moulding
and door frame. Firmly hold together the 2
items while installing the rivet.
41. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
UPPER
(a) Install a new front door outside moulding pad upper.
42. INSTALL NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
ET
INCORRECT
Riveter
43. INSTALL NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
44. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING SUBASSEMBLY
HINT:
When installing the front door outside moulding
assembly, heat the vehicle body and front door outside
moulding assembly using a heat light.
Heating temperature:
Mandrel
Item
Temperature
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
INCORRECT
Riveter
INCORRECT
Riveter
Riveter
INCORRECT
B146495E01
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding
excessively.
(a) Clean the vehicle body surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body
surface.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the vehicle
body.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with
cleaner.
(b) Clean the front door outside moulding subassembly. (If reusing the front door outside
moulding sub-assembly.)
(1) Using a heat light, heat the front door outside
moulding sub-assembly.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the front
door outside moulding sub-assembly.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with
cleaner.
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
ET–61
(4) Apply new double-sided tape to the front door
outside moulding sub-assembly.
(c) Install the front door outside moulding subassembly.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body and
front door outside moulding sub-assembly.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
front door outside moulding sub-assembly.
HINT:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
(3) Install the front door outside moulding subassembly with the 11 clips.
Double-sided Tape
B120274E01
(4) Install the nut.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
ET
B120273
ET–42
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
OUTSIDE MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT WHEEL OPENING
EXTENSION SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT BUMPER ASSEMBLY
FRONT BODY MUDGUARD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120182E01
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
ET–43
FRONT FENDER OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
NO. 1 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING PAD
NO. 2 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
ET
FRONT WHEEL OPENING OR ARCH MOULDING EXTENSION
Non-reusable part
B134261E01
ET–44
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
RIVET
ET
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120290E01
ET–45
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
MOULDING PAD UPPER
NO. 1 REAR DOOR
MOULDING PAD
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE
MOULDING PAD UPPER
NO. 3 OUTSIDE
MOULDING CLIP
NO. 4 OUTSIDE
MOULDING CLIP
NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
WHEEL HOUSE
SEAL FRONT
NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
RIVET
RIVET
RIVET
NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING RETAINER
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE MOULDING
Non-reusable part
B134262E01
ET
ET–46
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
ET
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
ROCKER PANEL MOULDING
SUB-ASSEMBLY
STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
NO. 1 OUTSIDE
MOULDING CLIP
NO. 1 ROCKER PANEL
MOULDING PROTECTOR
ROCKER PANEL MOULDING FRONT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120291E01
ET–47
EXTERIOR – OUTSIDE MOULDING
QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR RH
QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY REAR LH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
ET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR BUMPER
ASSEMBLY
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
REAR QUARTER OUTSIDE MOULDING SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
NO. 1 QUARTER PANEL
MOULDING PAD
NO. 3 OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
REAR QUARTER OUTSIDE MOULDING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B120292E01
ET–66
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
REMOVAL
HINT:
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
1.
Screw
Claw
Push
Claw
B065260E01
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
FRONT LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the moulding to 40 to 60°C
(104 to 140°F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the moulding excessively.
(c) Disengage the 2 claws by pushing the moulding and
remove the moulding.
NOTICE:
If reusing the moulding, take cake not to
damage the moulding.
INSTALLATION
1.
Caulking
Sponge
Non-woven
Fabric
ET
Adhesive
Tape
(2)
INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
FRONT LH
(a) Using a shop rag, remove the adhesive tape from
the moulding.
(1) Clean the contact surface of the body with a of
shop rag saturated with white gasoline.
(b) Clean the outer circumference of the moulding with
white gasoline.
(c) Apply new adhesive tape to the moulding, as shown
in the illustration.
Dimension:
A
(1)
(1) 50.0 mm (1.969 in.), (2) 330 mm (12.992 in.)
Adhesive Tape
B
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
A
C
(1) 1.2 mm (0.047 in.), (2) 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
(d) Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding.
Heating temperature:
Caulking Sponge
B
C
Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
B062961E01
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and moulding excessively.
(e) Remove the moulding release sheet from the
moulding face.
HINT:
Be careful for dirt or foreign objects not to stick to
the adhered part when peeling off the moulding
release sheet.
(f) Engage the 2 claws and install the moulding.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force onto the moulding,
but steady pressure with your thumbs.
ET–62
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING REAR LH
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR LOWER
FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR GLASS
WEATHERSTRIP INNER LH
CUSHION
RUBBER
26 (265, 19)
ET
FRONT DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
CUSHION
RUBBER
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
DOOR CHECK
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
FRONT NO. 2
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
SPEAKER
MOUNTING NO. 1
BRACKET
30 (306, 22)
26 (265, 19)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 42 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
FRONT NO. 1
SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
CLIP
CLIP
FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B134213E01
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
ET–63
REMOVAL
HINT:
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
1.
Screw
Claw
Push
Claw
B065259E01
REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the moulding to 40 to 60°C
(104 to 140°F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the moulding excessively.
(c) Disengage the 2 claws by pushing the moulding and
remove the moulding.
NOTICE:
If reusing the moulding, take care not to damage
the moulding.
INSTALLATION
Non-woven Fabric
1.
Caulking Sponge
(1)
Adhesive Tape
(2)
INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH
(a) Using a shop rag, remove the adhesive tape from
the moulding.
(1) Clean the contact surface of the body with shop
rag saturated with white gasoline.
(b) Clean the outer circumference of the moulding with
white gasoline.
(c) Apply new adhesive tape to the moulding, as shown
in the illustration.
Dimension:
A
(1) 330 mm (12.992 in.), (2) 265.0 mm (10.433 in.)
Adhesive Tape
B
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
A
C
(1) 0.8 mm (0.031 in.), (2) 1.2 mm (0.197 in.)
(d) Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding.
Heating temperature:
Caulking Sponge
B
C
Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
B062960E01
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and moulding excessively.
(e) Remove the moulding release sheet from the
moulding face.
HINT:
Be careful for dirt or foreign objects not to stick to
the adhered part when peeling off the moulding
release sheet.
(f) Engage the 2 claws and install the moulding.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force onto the moulding,
but steady pressure with your thumbs.
ET
EXTERIOR – SIDE STEP
ET–69
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SIDE STEP BRACKET
(a) Install the 3 brackets with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 19.5 N*m (199 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
2.
REMOVE LH STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the step sub-assembly with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
ET
ET–64
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD FRONT
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE COVER LH
REAR DOOR HANDLE
ASSEMBLY OUTSIDE LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING FRONT LH
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE PAD REAR
ET
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR QUARTER
WINDOW WEATHERSTRIP LH
REAR DOOR
GLASS SUBASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR QUARTER GLASS
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW DIVISION
BAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120200E03
ET–65
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
26 (265, 19)
DOOR CHECK
REAR DOOR HINGE
ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
26 (265, 19)
30 (306, 22)
26 (265, 19)
CHILD PROTECTOR
LOCK HOLE PLUG
REAR DOOR HINGE ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B134257E03
ET
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GARNISH
ET–71
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE
(a) Install the garnish with the 2 clips and 6 nuts.
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Install the service hole cover LH.
(b) Install the back door trim panel.
(c) Install the assist strap assembly RH.
(d) Install the assist strap hole cover.
ET
ET–67
EXTERIOR – SIDE STEP
SIDE STEP
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ET
LH STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
19.5 (199, 14)
NO. 3 SIDE STEP BRACKET
NO. 1 SIDE STEP BRACKET
NO. 2 SIDE STEP BRACKET
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B146598E01
ET–68
EXTERIOR – SIDE STEP
REMOVAL
HINT:
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
ET
1.
REMOVE LH STEP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 6 bolts holding the side step assembly
to the side step brackets.
(b) with Step light:
Disconnect the step light wiring connector.
(c) Remove the side step assembly.
2.
REMOVE SIDE STEP BRACKET
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and 3 brackets.
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GARNISH
ET–69
BACK DOOR GARNISH
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
CLIP
BACK DOOR GARNISH
SUB-ASSEMBLY OUTSIDE
ET
B134214E01
ASSIST STRAP HOLE COVER
ASSIST STRAP ASSEMBLY RH
SERVICE HOLE
COVER LH
BACK DOOR
TRIM BOARD
BACK DOOR TRIM COVER
Non-reusable part
B134215E03
ET–70
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR GARNISH
REMOVAL
ET
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTSIDE
(a) Remove the assist strap hole cover.
(b) Remove the assist strap assembly RH.
(c) Remove the back door trim panel.
(d) Remove the service hole cover LH.
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the 6 nuts.
(b) Disengage the 2 clips by pulling the garnish, and
remove the garnish.
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–7
REMOVAL
HINT:
A bolt without torque specification is a standard bolt (See
page SS-2).
1.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50
Split Seat Type)
HINT:
See page SE-36
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 SEAT LEG COVER NO. 2 (for 50/50
Split Seat Type)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seat lock.
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and seat lock.
6.
REMOVE SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4 (for 50/50 Split
Seat Type)
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 covers, 2 bolts
and anchor rail.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B076091
7.
REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
8.
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the deck board subassembly.
9.
REMOVE DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the deck board assembly.
B063596
10. REMOVE REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE
REAR
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and mat support plate.
B063594
IR
IR–8
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
11. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claws and
remove the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the bolt, deck floor box and luggage hold
belt striker.
B063597
12. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
13. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the trim cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
14. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH
(a) Remove the screw and side board.
15. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
(a) Remove the screw and side board.
16. REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the screw and side trim box.
17. REMOVE SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the screw and side trim box.
IR
Plate Cover
Claw
B064791E01
Claw B
Claw C
Claw A
Claw D
18. REMOVE QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INSIDE LH (for
50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and
covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and scuff plate.
19. REMOVE QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INSIDE RH (for
50/50 Split Seat Type)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
20. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw labeled A,
claw labeled B, 2 claws labeled C and claw labeled
D. Remove the scuff plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
21. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
B076924E01
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
Claw B
Claw D
Claw E
22. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw labeled A,
claw labeled B, 4 claws labeled C, claw labeled D
and claw labeled E. Remove the scuff plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
23. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
Claw A
Claw C
IR–9
B076922E02
24. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
(a) Remove the cap nut.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and
remove the trim board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
25. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
B076923E03
26. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
27. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
28. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
29. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
30. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR
31. REMOVE REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
Clip
Clip
Clip
Clip
B063598E02
32. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the screw and deck trim cover.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and clips.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 6 clips and
remove the side panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
33. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
IR
IR–10
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
34. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Remove the bolt and 3 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the 5 clips and side
panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
Clip
B076092E01
Clip
B
A
A
B
B
B063599E03
IR
Clip A
Clip B
B076093E01
Claw A
B
A
Clip
A
Claw B
35. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
36. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH
(a) Remove the screw and tonneau cover hook.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and clip.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 9 clips and
remove the side garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
37. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
38. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Remove the rear No. 2 shoulder anchor bolt.
(b) Remove the 3 screws, disengage the 4 clips labeled
A and 5 clips labeled B.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and
remove the side garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
39. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
40. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 6 claws labeled
A and 2 claws labeled B. Remove the 2 clips and
pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
41. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
A
B064143E01
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
42. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the front seat outer
belt (floor anchor side).
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 6 claws and clip,
and remove the pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
Claw
B063595E01
Clip B
Clip A
Claw
Claw
IR–11
43. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
44. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 assist grip plugs.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw. Remove
the clip labeled A, clip labeled B and pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B063600E03
120 mm
700 mm
Adhesive Tape
(d) Pull the garnish upward, and remove the pillar
garnish from the instrument panel.
(e) w/ Curtain shield airbag:
Protect the curtain shield airbag LH.
(1) Thoroughly cover the airbag with cloth or nylon
of 700 mm (27.56 in.) x 120 mm (4.72 in.) and
fix the ends of the cover with adhesive tape, as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Cover the curtain shield airbag with the
protection cover as soon as the front pillar
garnish is removed.
45. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
46. REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
Adhesive Tape
Protective Cover
B065292E08
IR
IR–12
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
Claw
Clip
47. REMOVE ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a moulding remover, disengage the 3 claws
and 2 clips.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the map light switch connector and
sliding roof switch connector, and remove the
console box.
Claw
Clip
B063602E02
48. REMOVE INTERIOR LIGHT ASSEMBLY NO. 1
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and
remove the interior light lens.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Protective Tape
B120248E01
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and
remove the 2 covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
IR
Protective Tape
B120249E03
Protective Tape
B120250E01
(c) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–13
(d) Remove the No. 1 roof wire from the claw of the
interior light.
(e) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and
remove the interior light switch base and the interior
light.
49. REMOVE DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY (w/ RSE)
HINT:
See page AV-177
Protective Tape
50. REMOVE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (w/ RSE)
HINT:
See page AV-176
B120251E01
51. REMOVE VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and visor assembly.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and visor sub-assembly.
52. REMOVE VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
53. REMOVE VISOR HOLDER
(a) Remove the screw and visor holder.
B063601
IR
IR–14
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
with Sliding Roof
Clip
without Sliding Roof
Clip
54. REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Disengage the 4 clips and remove the headlining.
B064607E02
IR
without Sliding Roof
INSTALLATION
Double-stick Tape
1.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the marking, and then install the wire harness
with tape.
HINT:
Be careful for dirt or foreign objects not to stick to
the adhered part when peeling off the double-stick
tape.
(b) Attach the roof wire harness along the adhered part.
NOTICE:
Roof wire harness should be attached securely.
(c) Install the roof headlining with the 4 clips.
2.
INSTALL VISOR HOLDER
(a) Install the screw and visor holder.
with Sliding Roof (without RSE)
Double-stick Tape
with Sliding Roof (with RSE)
Double-stick Tape
B120287E01
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
3.
INSTALL VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the 2 screws and visor sub-assembly.
(b) Install the 2 screws and visor assembly.
4.
INSTALL VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
5.
INSTALL INTERIOR LIGHT ASSEMBLY NO. 1
(a) Install interior light switch base and the interior light,
and engage the 4 claws.
(b) Install the No. 1 roof wire to the claw of the interior
light.
(c) Engage the 4 claws.
(d) Install the 2 covers and engage the 4 claws.
(e) Install the interior light lens and engage the 4 claws.
6.
INSTALL DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY (w/ RSE)
HINT:
See page AV-177
7.
INSTALL TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (w/ RSE)
HINT:
See page AV-177
8.
INSTALL ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the console box and reconnect the map light
switch connector and sliding roof switch connector.
(b) Engage the 3 claws and 2 clips.
B063601
Claw
Claw
9.
Clip
Clip
INSTALL INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
B063602E02
Clip B
Clip A
IR–15
Claw
10. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Install the clip labeled A, clip labeled B and pillar
garnish, and engage the claw.
(b) Install 2 bolts.
(c) Install the 2 assist grip plugs.
11. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
Claw
B063600E03
12. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER LH
(a) Install the pillar garnish and engage the 6 claws.
(b) Install the 2 bolts.
IR
IR–16
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
(c) Install the front seat outer belt (floor anchor side)
and install the bolt.
13. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH UPPER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
Clip
Claw
B063595E01
Claw A
14. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
(a) Install the 2 clips and pillar garnish. And engage the
6 claws labeled A and 2 claws labeled B.
B
A
Clip
A
Claw B
A
B064143E01
IR
15. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
16. INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH
(a) Install the side garnish and engage the 9 clips.
(b) Install the 3 bolts and clip.
(c) Install the tonneau cover hook and the screw.
17. INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
18. INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
LH (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Install the side garnish and engage the 4 screws.
(b) Engage the 4 clips labeled A and 5 clips labeled B,
and install the 3 screws.
(c) Install the rear No. 2 shoulder anchor bolt.
19. INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER
RH (for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
Clip A
Clip B
B076093E01
20. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the side panel and engage the 6 clips.
(b) Install the 3 screws and clips.
(c) Install the screw and deck trim cover.
Clip
Clip
Clip
21. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
22. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Install the side panel and the 5 clips.
Clip
B063598E02
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–17
(b) Install the 3 screws and the bolt.
Clip
Clip
23. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(for 50/50 Split Seat Type)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
24. INSTALL REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
25. INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
B076092E01
26. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
27. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
28. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
29. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
30. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
(a) Install the trim board and engage the 2 claws.
(b) Install the cap nut.
Claw
31. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
B076923E03
32. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Install the scuff plate. Engage the claw labeled A,
claw labeled B, 4 claws labeled C, claw labeled D
and claw labeled E.
Claw B
Claw D
Claw E
Claw A
Claw C
B076922E02
34. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Install the scuff plate. Engage the claw labeled A,
claw labeled B, 2 claws labeled C and claw labeled
D.
Claw B
Claw C
Claw A
33. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
Claw D
B076924E01
35. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
IR
IR–18
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
Plate Cover
Claw
36. INSTALL QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INSIDE LH (for
50/50 Split Seat Type)
(a) Install the scuff plate and the 2 bolts.
(b) Engage the 4 claws and covers.
37. INSTALL QUARTER SCUFF PLATE INSIDE RH (for
50/50 Split Seat Type)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
B064791E01
38. INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the side trim box and the screws.
39. INSTALL SIDE TRIM BOX ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the side trim box and the screws.
40. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR LH
(a) Install the side board and the screw.
41. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD UPR RH
(a) Install the side board and the screw.
42. INSTALL DECK TRIM COVER REAR
(a) Install the trim cover.
43. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
(a) Install the deck floor box, luggage hold belt and bolt.
(b) Install the cover and the claws.
IR
44. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
B063597
45. INSTALL REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
(a) Install the mat support plate and 5 bolts.
B063594
46. INSTALL DECK BOARD ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the deck board assembly and the 2 bolts.
47. INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the deck board sub-assembly and the 2 bolts.
48. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
49. INSTALL SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4 (for 50/50 Split
Seat Type)
(a) Install the 2 covers, 2 bolts and anchor rail.
B063596
50. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the seat lock and 2 bolts.
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–19
51. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the seat lock and 2 bolts.
52. INSTALL NO. 3 SEAT LEG COVER NO. 2 (for 50/50
Split Seat Type)
53. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (for 50/50
Split Seat Type)
HINT:
See page SE-38
B076091
54. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER RETRACTOR SUBASSEMBLY
IR
INTERIOR – FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
IR–1
FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage 2 clips and remove
the footrest.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B062589
IR
IR–2
INTERIOR – FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
INSTALLATION
1.
IR
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
(a) Install the footrest clips by engaging the claws with
the footrest.
HINT:
Before the installation, check that the part of footrest
to be engaged with the clips is not damaged.
NOTICE:
If it is damaged, replace it with a new one.
IR–2
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
ROOF HEADLINING
INTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH
UPPER RH
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
ASSIST GRIP
ASSEMBLY
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER RH
TONNEAU COVER HOOK
IR
COVER
FRONT PILLAR
GARNISH RH
DECK FLOOR BOX RH
COVER
SIDE DECK TRIM
PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
COVER
FRONT DOOR SCUFF
PLATE RH
COVER
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
COVER
DECK TRIM COVER NO. 1
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH
LOWER RH
DECK TRIM COVER NO. 1
FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
DECK BOARD SUB-ASSEMBLY
B120186E09
IR–3
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT PLATE REAR
DECK TROM COVER REAR RH
REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
DECK TROM COVER REAR LH
COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
CENTER PILLAR
GARNISH UPPER LH
COVER
42 (430, 31)
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
42 (430, 31)
COVER
ASSIST GRIP
ASSEMBLY
TONNEAU
COVER HOOK
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER LH
FRONT PILLAR
GARNISH LH
SIDE DECK TRIM PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120187E07
IR
IR–4
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
with REAR NO. 2 SEAT:
ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSEMBLY INNER RH
NO. 3 SEAT LEG
COVER NO. 2
CUP HOLDER
REAR FLOOR SEAT
LOCK COVER
COVER
QUARTER SCUFF
PLATE INSIDE RH
REAR DOOR
SCUFF PLATE RH
REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK
ASSEMBLY RH
SEAT ANCHOR RAIL NO. 4
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
IR
REAR FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
ROOF SIDE GARNISH
ASSEMBLY INNER LH
NO. 3 SEAT LEG
COVER NO. 2
ROPE HOOK
ROPE HOOK
CUP HOLDER
REAR FLOOR MAT SUPPORT
PLATE REAR
REAR NO. 2 SEAT LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
QUARTER TRIM
JACK COVER
COVER
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
QUARTER SCUFF
PLATE INSIDE LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
B120188E02
IR–5
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
ASSIST GRIP ASSEMBLY
COAT HOOK RH
ROOF HEADLINING
ASSEMBLY
FRONT ASSIST GRIP PLUG
VISOR SUBASSEMBLY RH
INTERIOR LIGHT
ASSEMBLY NO. 1
INTERIOR LIGHT
ASSEMBLY NO. 1
ROOF CONSOLE
BOX ASSEMBLY
VISOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
COAT HOOK LH
VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
ASSIST GRIP
ASSEMBLY
VISOR HOLDER
FRONT ASSIST GRIP PLUG
VISOR HOLDER
VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT ASSIST GRIP PLUG
B120189E04
IR
IR–6
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
with SLIDING ROOF:
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
with RSE:
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
IR
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
DOME LIGHT ASSEMBLY
DOME LIGHT LENS
ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSEMBLY
B134268E01
RF–3
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM:
Symptom
AUTO function does not operate
Sliding roof system does not operate
Sliding roof system stops operation halfway
Suspected area
See page
Sliding roof motor assembly
RF-2
1. POWER fuse
-
2. POWER relay
-
3. Sliding roof housing assembly
RF-6
4. Sliding roof motor switch assembly
RF-7
5. Sliding roof motor assembly
RF-2
6. Wire harness
RF-7
1. Sliding roof motor assembly
RF-2
2. Wire harness
RF-7
3. Sliding roof housing assembly
RF-6
RF
RF–4
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT WINDOW LOCK SWITCH
(a) Check that operation of the door glasses except the
driver side door glass, the back door glass and the
roof glass are disabled when the window lock switch
of the power window master switch is pressed.
(b) Check that the door glasses, the back door glass
and the roof glass can be operated when the
window lock switch is pressed again.
2.
INSPECT AUTO SLIDE-OPEN/CLOSE FUNCTION
(a) Check that the sliding roof switch can operate the
roof glass as follows while the tilt-UP / DOWN
function is not operating:
Result
Condition
•Ignition switch ON
•Window lock switch OFF
Switch
Switch Operation
SLIDE OPEN
TILT UP
Pressed more than 0.3 sec.
Roof Glass
Fully open
Fully closed
HINT:
The roof glass stops partway when the sliding roof
switch is pushed on either side during AUTO
operation.
3.
RF
INSPECT AUTO TILT UP/DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the sliding roof switch can operate the
roof glass as follows while the slide-OPEN/CLOSE
function is not operating:
Result
Condition
•Ignition switch ON
•Window lock switch OFF
Switch
Switch Operation
TILT UP
SLIDE OPEN
Pressed more than 0.3 sec.
Roof Glass
Fully tilted up
Fully closed
HINT:
The roof glass stops partway when the sliding roof
switch is pushed on either side during AUTO
operation.
4.
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF OPERATION FUNCTION
AFTER IGNITION SWITCH OFF
(a) Under both of the following conditions, check that
the door glasses, the back door glass and the roof
glass can be operated even after the ignition switch
is turned OFF:
• Within 43 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned OFF
• The driver side door is closed
5.
CHECK DEFLECTOR OPERATION
(a) Check deflector AUTO operation.
(1) Run the vehicle with the sliding roof fully open,
and check that the deflector lowers (AUTO
DOWN) as the vehicle speed increases and
rises (AUTO UP) as the vehicle speed
decreases.
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
RF–5
(2) Check that the deflector lowers according to
the vehicle speeds when the sliding roof has
been fully opened while the vehicle is running.
(b) Check that the sliding roof automatically tilts UP/
DOWN depending on the vehicle speed.
(1) Conditions that enable the sliding roof to
automatically tilt DOWN:
• Sliding roof in fully open position
• Sliding roof in UP position
• Vehicle speed 80 km/h (50 mph) or less
(during acceleration)
(2) Conditions that enable the sliding roof to
automatically tilts UP:
• Sliding roof in fully open position
• Sliding roof in DOWN position
• Vehicle speed 60 km/h (37 mph) or less
(during deceleration)
6.
INSPECT JAM PROTECTION FUNCTION
HINT:
The jam protection function prevents any part of your
body from getting caught by accident between the
vehicle body and the roof glass during roof glass
operation.
Operative condition:
• AUTO CLOSE
• AUTO CLOSE during sliding roof operation after the
ignition switch is turned OFF
• AUTO TILT-DOWN
• AUTO TILT-DOWN during sliding roof operation after
the ignition switch is turned OFF
CAUTION:
• Do not check this function using a part of your
body such as a hand. Also, pay thorough
attention that nothing gets caught by accident in
this process.
• If checking this function with something thin (less
than 5 mm [0.20 in.]) inserted between the glass
and vehicle body, this function may not operate.
(a) When the slide-OPEN/CLOSE function is operating:
Check that the roof glass opens by approximately
200 mm (7.87 in.) right when something gets caught
between the vehicle body and the roof glass during
roof glass operation.
B065141
RF
RF–6
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
(b) When the tilt-UP/DOWN function is operating:
Check that the roof glass fully tilts up when
something gets caught between the vehicle body
and the roof glass during roof glass operation.
7.
B065142
RF
INSPECT FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) If the roof glass is not closed because the jam
protection function operates improperly, perform
following operation. Then, you can close the roof
glass using the manual operation function.
(1) Press the sliding roof switch on TILT UP side
and hold it for 10 seconds after the jam
protection function operates. Then you can use
the manual operation function.
RF–8
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ROOF WIND DEFLECTOR PANEL
ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF DRIVE CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
3.
ADJUST FULLY CLOSED POSITION
(a) Using a screwdriver, slide the drive cable of the
sliding roof to align the matchmarks.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
INSTALL ROOF DRIP CHANNEL REAR
5.
INSTALL SUNSHADE TRIM KNOB
(a) Install the trim knob with the 2 screws.
6.
INSTALL SUNSHADE TRIM SUB-ASSEMBLY
7.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF SUNSHADE STOPPER
8.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the housing sub-assembly with the 6 nuts.
(b) Install the 4 brackets with the 8 bolts.
(c) Connect the 4 drain hoses.
9.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the drive gear with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the sliding roof motor switch connector.
Matchmarks
B064332E01
RF
B063617
10. ADJUST SLIDING ROOF GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the difference in level between the sliding
roof (weatherstrip) and roof panel.
Dimension (Circumference:
0 +- 2.0 mm (0 +- 0.079 in.)
B063346
(b) Check the difference in level between the sliding
roof (glass) and roof panel front end and rear end.
NOTICE:
The clearance should be even all around.
B063347
11. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a "torx" wrench T25, loosen a screw to adjust
the sliding roof panel position. When the adjustment
has been done, tighten the screw there.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
(b) Reset the sliding roof drive gear (See page RF-2).
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
RF–9
(c) Check the sliding roof operation function (See page
RF-2).
HINT:
If the jam protection function is not activated, reset
the sliding roof drive gear again.
12. CHECK FOR WATER LEAK
(a) Adjusting the sliding roof, check that there is no
water leak.
If a leak is found, readjust the sliding roof.
13. INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
See page IR-14
RF
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
RF–1
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
RF
SLIDING ROOF MOTOR SWITCH
SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(SLIDING ROOF CONTROL ECU)
B120205E02
RF–2
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
INITIALIZATION
1.
RF
RESET SLIDING ROOF MOTOR
(a) If the AUTO operation function does not operate,
reset the sliding roof motor using either of the
following ways.
(1) Press the sliding roof switch on TILT UP side
and hold it. When the roof glass stops at the fully
tilted-up position, the reset of the motor is
completed.
(2) Fully open the roof glass, press the sliding roof
switch on SLIDE OPEN side and hold it for 10
seconds. 10 seconds later, the reset of the motor
is completed.
HINT:
If the battery terminal is disconnected or after
the jam protection function has operated, the
ECU of the sliding roof motor may not detect the
position of the roof glass. If the AUTO operation
function is still disabled even if the sliding roof
motor is reset, the hall IC (built in the sliding roof
motor assembly) for detecting the roof glass
position may malfunction.
RF–5
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
SLIDING ROOF
BODY
COMPONENTS
4.0 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
SLIDING ROOF GLASS
SUB-ASSEMBLY
SLIDING ROOF SIDE
GARNISH RH
SLIDING ROOF
GUIDE RAIL
COVER RH
SUNSHADE TRIM
SLIDING ROOF GUIDE
RAIL COVER LH
SLIDING ROOF SIDE
GARNISH LH
RF
SUNSHADE TRIM KNOB
SLIDING ROOF SUNSHADE STOPPER
ROOF WIND DEFLECTOR
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
SLIDING ROOF DRIVE
CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
SLIDING ROOF
DRIVE GEAR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B120206E02
RF–6
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
REMOVAL
HINT:
The installation is in the reverse order of the removal.
However, when there is a special point concerning the
installation, it is indicated.
1.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
See page IR-7
2.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GUIDE RAIL COVER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the rail cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GUIDE RAIL COVER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described above for the LH
side.
4.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF SIDE GARNISH LH
(a) Using screwdriver, pry out the garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF SIDE GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described above for the LH
side.
6.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a "torx" wrench (T25), remove the 4 screws.
(b) Pull the glass upward to remove it.
7.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 4 drain hoses from the housing.
(b) Remove the 8 bolts and 4 brackets.
(c) Remove the 6 nuts and housing sub-assembly.
8.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the sliding roof motor switch connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the drive gear subassembly.
9.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF SUNSHADE STOPPER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the sliding roof
sunshade stopper.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
RF
B063615
B063617
10. REMOVE SUNSHADE TRIM SUB-ASSEMBLY
RF–7
SLIDING ROOF – SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
11. REMOVE SUNSHADE TRIM KNOB
(a) Remove the 2 screws and trim knob.
12. REMOVE ROOF DRIP CHANNEL REAR
(a) Slide the drip channel backward and remove it.
13. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF DRIVE CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, slide the drive cable backward
and remove it.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
14. REMOVE ROOF WIND DEFLECTOR PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
B064673
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF MOTOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the sliding roof motor switch (See page IR7).
(b) Check the continuity between the terminals when
operating the switch.
Standard resistance
Terminals No.
Switch Operation
Specified Condition
1-3
TILT UP is pressed
Below 1 Ω
2-3
SLIDE OPEN is pressed
Below 1 Ω
1, 2 - 3
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
B059681
INSPECT HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FOR
SLIDING ROOF MOTOR ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the sliding roof motor connector (See
page IR-7).
(b) Check the connector terminals of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard
Terminals No.
Condition
Specified Condition
8 - Body ground
Constant
Below 1 Ω
9-8
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
10 - 8
Constant
10 to 14 V
1-8
Constant
Below 1 Ω
7-8
TILT UP is pressed
Below 1 Ω
6-8
SLIDE OPEN is pressed
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
RF
MP–3
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the multiplex
communication system.
• The intelligent tester should be used in step 2.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result
Result
B
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
GO TO DTC CHART
A
3
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU (See page MP-4).
NEXT
4
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
5
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
Proceed to
MP
MP–4
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the 1B, 1E, 1F, 1H and 1L J/B
connectors.
Vehicle Rear Side
Vehicle Front Side
1F
1E
1B
Body ECU
1F
1E
1B
1L
1H
MP
B065658E01
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BECU (1F-12) - Body
ground
W-R - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
BECU (1B-4) - Body
ground
W-R - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
BECU (1L-4) - Body
ground
W-R - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
BDR1 (1E-9) - Body
ground
G-W - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
GND1 (1H-2) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground for main power
supply
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 (1H-2) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground for main power
supply
Always
Below 1 Ω
MP–5
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
2.
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY (THEFT
DETERRENT ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T5 connector.
T5
B050657E08
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B1 (T5-2) - Body ground
W-R - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
+B2 (T5-3) - Body ground
W-L - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
W-B - Body ground
Ground for main power
supply
Always
Below 1 Ω
E (T5-29) - Body ground
3.
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
(BACK DOOR ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B8 connector.
B8
B062706E05
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BDR (B8-4)- Body ground
L - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
BECU (B8-5) - Body
ground
L-R - Body ground
Power source (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (B8-3) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground for main power
supply
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
MP
MP–6
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG SG
SIL
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) The network gateway ECU controls the functions of
the multiplex communication system on the vehicle.
Data of the multiplex communication system and
the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) can be read
through the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the
vehicle.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle's ECU uses the ISO 1565-4 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement
of the DLC3 complies with SAEJ 1962 and matches
the ISO 15765-4 format.
BAT
E106867E03
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Terminal Description
Bus "+" line
Condition
During transmission
Specified Condition
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
MP
3.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
(a) The BEAN communication line consists of 2
systems:
One is a system with a loop-shaped line that the
back door ECU is united with the body ECU present
in the center of the line. Another is a system that the
body ECU and the theft deterrent ECU are
connected alone.
Since the line for the back door ECU is loopshaped, the communication can be maintained by
the line that is not open even if part of the line
become open for some reason. In the case that
there is a short-circuit (bus-down) in the line,
however, all the BEAN communication becomes
impossible in the system and some DTCs are
output.
HINT:
• When bus-down occurs, communication from the
related ECU stops. Therefore, DTC cannot be
output, so perform a DTC (SAE code) inspection
using the intelligent tester.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
4.
MP–7
• The theft deterrent ECU and the back door ECU
have a single communication line. Therefore, if
the line has a short-circuit (bus-down), the BEAN
communication will be impossible and DTCs will
not be output, either.
COMMUNICATION FUNCTION INSPECTION
(a) Inspect the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
(b) Inspect the diagnosis monitor code output.
(1) Check a diagnosis code for the body ECU by
connecting the intelligent tester to the DLC3 and
turning the ignition switch ON.
(2) When the display shows diagnostic codes of the
ECU unconnected and the communication bus
defective, perform the inspection depending on
the troubleshooting.
HINT:
When other diagnostic code is output, refer to
the diagnostic code table and check the
applicable section.
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
DLC3
A066288E02
2.
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS/OBD/
MOBD/BODY/DTC INFO.
(d) Check the DTCs on the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch on.
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS/OBD/
MOBD/BODY/DTC INFO.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
MP
MP–8
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If malfunction code is displayed during DTC check, check the
circuit corresponding to the code in the table below. Proceed
to the page given for the circuit.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
MP
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B1214
Short to B+ in Door System
Communication Bus Malfunction
1. Theft warning ECU assembly
(Theft deterrent ECU)
2. Multiplex network door ECU
back (Back door ECU)
3. Wire harness
4. Instrument panel junction block
assembly (Body ECU)
MP-9
B1215
Short to GND in Door System
Communication Bus Malfunction
1. Theft warning ECU assembly
(Theft deterrent ECU)
2. Multiplex network door ECU
back (Back door ECU)
3. Wire harness
4. Instrument panel junction block
assembly (Body ECU)
MP-9
B1269
Theft Deterrent ECU
Communication Stop
1. Theft warning ECU assembly
(Theft deterrent ECU)
2. Wire harness
MP-14
B1287
Back Door ECU Communication
Stop
1. Multiplex network door ECU
back (Back door ECU)
2. Wire harness
MP-18
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–9
DTC
B1214
Short to B+ in Door System Communication
Bus Malfunction
DTC
B1215
Short to GND in Door System Communication
Bus Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
B1214 and B1215 are output when +B and the body ground is short-circuited on the communication bus.
Detecting this condition disables all the BEAN communication and outputs some DTCs.
DTC No.
B1214
B1215
DTC Detection Condition
Door system communication circuit and +B battery
system short
Door system communication circuit and body ground
short
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Theft warning ECU assembly (Theft deterrent ECU)
Multiplex network door ECU back (Back door ECU)
Wire harness
Instrument panel junction block assembly (Body
ECU)
•
•
•
•
Theft warning ECU assembly (Theft deterrent ECU)
Multiplex network door ECU back (Back door ECU)
Wire harness
Instrument panel junction block assembly (Body
ECU)
MP
MP–10
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel Junction Block Assembly (Body ECU)
26
MPX3
B6
23
MPX2
B4
BR-R
BR-Y
A14 IE1
B
J19
J/C
BR-R
B
9 BD1
BR-Y
R
1 B8
MPX2
31 T5
MPX1
MP
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
(Theft deterrent ECU)
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back door ECU)
B065155E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (A ECU)
(a) Check whether the output of the DTC stops when the A
ECU connector is disconnected.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–11
Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
B ECU
(Back Door ECU)
(Theft deterrent ECU)
B063900E01
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational
sequence, and start the next step after the connector
in connected.
HINT:
In this case, the A ECU in the represents the back door
ECU.
OK:
When the output of the DTC stops, the
disconnected A ECU is abnormal.
OK
REPLACE A ECU
NG
2
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (B ECU)
(a) Check whether the output of the DTC stops when the B
ECU connector is disconnected.
MP
MP–12
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
B ECU
(Back Door ECU)
(Theft deterrent ECU)
B065156E01
OK:
Neither DTC B1214 nor DTC B1215 is output.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational
sequence, and start the next step after the connector
in connected.
HINT:
In this case, the B ECU in the represents the theft
deterrent ECU.
OK:
When the output of the DTC stops, the
disconnected B ECU is abnormal.
MP
OK
REPLACE B ECU
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS BETWEEN BODY ECU AND A ECU OR B ECU
(a) Disconnect the A ECU, B ECU and body ECU
connectors.
(b) Check the wire harness (MPX line) between the A ECU,
B ECU and body ECU.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–13
Body ECU
Communication Circuit
MPX Line
MPX Line
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
B ECU
(Back Door ECU)
(Theft deterrent ECU)
B063902E01
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Check the voltage between the wire harness (MPX
line) and body ground.
Standard voltage
MPX line - Body ground
Specified Condition
Body ECU or A ECU (Back door ECU) - Body ground
Below 1 V
Body ECU or B ECU (Theft deterrent ECU) - Body ground
Below 1 V
If the output voltage is not Below 1V, the wire
harness (MPX line) may be short-circuited with +B.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness (MPX
lines) and body ground.
Standard resistance
MPX line - Body ground
Specified Condition
Body ECU or A ECU (Back door ECU) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Body ECU or B ECU (Theft deterrent ECU) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
If there is Below 1 Ω, the wire harness (MPX line)
and body ground may be short-circuited with the
body ground.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
BETWEEN BODY ECU AND A ECU OR B
ECU
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
MP
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–1
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
COMMUNICATION
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
(THEFT DETERRENT ECU)
MP
INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
- BODY ECU
MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU BACK
(BACK DOOR ECU)
C131375E01
MP–2
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
1.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
DESCRIPTION
(a) The BEAN communication line is used to control the
following items:
• Instrument panel junction block assembly (Body
ECU)
• Theft warning ECU assembly (Theft deterrent
ECU)
• Multiplex network door ECU back (Back door
ECU)
If there is a short-circuit (bus-down) in the line,
communication to the system that had a short-circuit
(bus-down) will be disabled and the DTC
concerning the system will be output from the
multiplex network body ECU.
Instrument Panel Junction Block Assembly (Body ECU)
26
MPX3
B6
MP
BR-Y
23
MPX2
B4
BR-R
A14 IE1
B
J19
J/C
BR-R
B
9 BD1
BR-Y
R
31 T5
MPX1
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
(Theft deterrent ECU)
1 B8
MPX2
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back door ECU)
B065155E01
MP–14
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1269
Theft Deterrent ECU Communication Stop
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1269 is output when the communication between the theft deterrent ECU and the body ECU stops
for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1269
MP
DTC Detection Condition
Theft deterrent ECU communication stop
Trouble Area
•
•
Theft warning ECU assembly (Theft deterrent ECU)
Wire harness
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–15
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
Instrument Panel
Junction Block Assembly
Engine Room R/B
Passenger Side J/B
W-R
ECU-B
2
1
4
1B
2
2
W-R
W
4
1L
W-R
B
3E
B
3E
2
T5 +B1
SECU/HORN
ALT
2
1
J/B
2 1
2
1
1C
2
10
1K
3
T5 +B2
W-L
B
MPX3
2
26
B6
J19
J/C
BR-Y
B
BR-Y
B
31
T5 MPX1
L-W
2
2
1
MP
J24
J/C
Short Pin
W-B
2
A
29
T5 E
B
Battery
II
B065157E01
MP–16
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BODY ECU - THEFT DETERRENT ECU)
(a) Check the wire harness between the body ECU and theft
deterrent ECU.
(1) Disconnect the B6 and T5 connectors.
(2) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B6
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Assembly (Body ECU)
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
MPX3 (B6-26) - MPX1
(T5-31)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B064050E01
MP
OK
2
INSPECT THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the T5 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
B065163E01
OK
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
+B1 (T5-2) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
+B2 (T5-3) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
MP–17
INSPECT THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the T5 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Warning ECU Assembly
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E (T5-29) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
B065163E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSEMBLY
MP
MP–18
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1287
Back Door ECU Communication Stop
DESCRIPTION
B1287 is output when the communication between the multiplex network door ECU back (back door ECU)
and multiplex network body ECU stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1287
MP
DTC Detection Condition
Back door ECU communication stop
Trouble Area
•
•
Multiplex network door ECU back (Back door ECU)
Wire harness
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–19
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
Instrument Panel
Junction Block Assembly
Engine Room R/B
W-R
ECU-B
2
1
2
2
4
1B
2
1
1C
12
1F
W-R
7
BD1
L-R
1
1F
L-O
6
BD1
L
5
B8 BECU
W
ALT
2
1
J/B
21
2
Power
1
2
4
B8 BDR
B
BR-R
23
MPX2 B4
2
A14
IE1
BR-R
9
1
R
BD1
B8 MPX2
MP
L-W
Short Pin
2
2
1
A
J41
2
J/C
A
J40
W-B
10
BD1
W-B
3
B8 GND
W-B
B
Battery
BL
B065158E01
MP–20
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BODY ECU - BACK DOOR ECU)
(a) Check the wire harness between the body ECU and
back door ECU.
(1) Disconnect the B4 and B8 connectors.
(2) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B4
Instrument Panel Junction
Block Assembly (Body ECU)
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
MPX2 (B4-23) - MPX2
(B8-1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
B8
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
B064051E02
MP
OK
2
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU (BACK DOOR ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B8 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
B8
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
B065162E01
OK
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
BECU (B8-5) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
BDR (B8-4) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
MP–21
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU (BACK DOOR ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B8 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B8
Multiplex Network Door ECU Back
(Back Door ECU)
B065162E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
GND (B8-3) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK DOOR ECU (BACK DOOR ECU)
MP
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–3
PARTS LOCATION
MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
(SKID CONTROL ECU)
CA
CAN J/C
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
ECM
DLC3
YAW RATE SENSOR
C131374E01
CA–4
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Serial Communication Line (SIL)
Skid Control
ECU
DLC3
CAN J/C
ECM
120 Ω
+- 10%
120 Ω
+- 10%
: CAN Main Bus Line
(CAN-H)
: CAN Main Bus Line
(CAN-L)
Steering Angle
Sensor
Yaw Rate
Sensor
CA
: CAN Sub Bus Line
(CAN-H)
: CAN Sub Bus Line
(CAN-L)
C134075E01
HINT:
• The skid control ECU stores DTCs and performs DTC
communication by receiving information from the steering
angle sensor and yaw rate sensor. These sensors cannot
store DTCs or perform DTC communication.
• The ECM uses the CAN communication system to perform
DTC communication instead of the conventional serial
communication line (SIL).
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: HOW TO PROCEED WITH TR...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 D
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Networking
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000022YR008X
Title: CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING (2007 4Runner)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE:
z
DTCs for the CAN communication system as follows:
z
U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95, U0126/63, U0100/65.
Refer to troubleshooting of each system if DTCs regarding the CAN communication system are not
output.
1.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTCs
NEXT
2.
CHECK CAN BUS LINE
NEXT
3.
CHECK USING INTELLIGENT TESTER VIA CAN VIM
(a) Select the "BUS CHECK"
.
Result:
PROCEED TO
A
RESULT
A
All ECUs and sensors connected to the CAN communication system are displayed.
B
An ECU or sensor not connected to the CAN communication system is displayed.
C
A few ECUs or sensors not connected to the CAN communication system are displayed.
B
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE TABLE
C
CHECK FOR AN OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF THE
CAN SUB BUS LINE
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: HOW TO PROCEED WITH TR...
4.
CHECK DTC COMBINATION TABLE
(a) Confirm trouble according to the combination of output DTCs regarding the CAN
communication system.
HINT:
Previous CAN communication system DTCs may be the cause if CAN communication system DTCs are
output and all ECUs and sensors connected to the CAN communication system are displayed on the
intelligent tester's "BUS CHECK" screen via the CAN VIM.
NEXT
5.
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
6.
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
7.
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8.
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: CAN Bus Line (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 J
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Networking
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002AG0006X
Title: CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: CAN Bus Line (2007 4Runner)
CAN Bus Line
DESCRIPTION
When any DTC of the CAN communication system is output, first measure the resistance between the
terminals of the DLC3 and the yaw rate sensor connector to specify the trouble area.
WIRING DIAGRAM
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: CAN Bus Line (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
1.
CHECK CAN BUS WIRE (MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION, BUS LINES FOR
SHORT CIRCUIT)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: CAN Bus Line (2007 4Runner)
TESTER
CONNECTION
CONDITION
D1-6 (CANH) - D114 (CANL)
D1-6 (CANH) - D114 (CANL)
D1-6 (CANH) - D114 (CANL)
NGA
NGB
z
z
z
z
z
z
SPECIFIED
VALUE
RESULT
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
69 Ω or
higher
NG-A
Below 54 Ω
NG-B
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
CHECK CAN MAIN BUS LINE FOR
DISCONNECTION
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT
CIRCUIT
OK
2.
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
TESTER CONNECTION
CONDITION
SPECIFIED
VALUE
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
z
z
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch 1 MΩ or higher
OFF
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
z
IG switch OFF
NG
z
Stop light switch 1 MΩ or higher
OFF
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: CAN Bus Line (2007 4Runner)
3.
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
TESTER CONNECTION
CONDITION
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6
(CANH)
z
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
z
z
z
SPECIFIED
VALUE
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
NG
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
OK
GO TO HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4R...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 U
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Networking
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000022YT008X
Title: CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4Runner)
TERMINALS OF ECU
HINT:
This section describes the standard CAN values for all CAN related components.
1. CAN J/C
(a) CAN J/C connectors.
HINT:
z
z
The connectors connected to the CAN J/C can be distinguished by the colors of the bus lines and
the connecting side of the connector.
J48, J49, J50 and J51 are interchangeable.
CAN J/C CONNECTORS
COLOR (CAN-H SIDE)
COLOR (CAN-L SIDE)
ECM (J51)
L
LG
DLC3 (J50)
P
V
Steering angle sensor (J49)
B
Y
("A" SIDE, WITH EARTH TERMINAL)
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4R...
Yaw rate sensor (J48)
W
CAN J/C CONNECTORS
R
COLOR (CAN-H SIDE)
COLOR (CAN-L SIDE)
B
W
("B" SIDE, WITHOUT EARTH TERMINAL)
Skid control ECU (J47)
(b) The terminals of the CAN J/C connectors.
TERMINAL
TERMINAL SYMBOL
1
CANH
2
CANL
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
TERMINALS
SPECIFIED VALUE
CANH - CANL
108 to 132 Ω
2. DLC3
(a) Check DLC3.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance:
TERMINALS
TERMINAL
CONDITION
SPECIFIED
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4R...
DESCRIPTION
VALUE
D1-6 (CANH) HIGH-level CAN IG switch OFF,
- D1-14
bus line - LOWstop light
54 to 69 Ω
(CANL)
level CAN bus line
switch OFF
D1-6 (CANH)
- D1-16
(BAT)
HIGH-level CAN IG switch OFF,
bus line - Battery
stop light
positive
switch OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
D1-14
(CANL) - D116 (BAT)
LOW-level CAN
IG switch OFF,
bus line - Battery
stop light
positive
switch OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
D1-6 (CANH)
-D1-4 (CG)
HIGH-level CAN
bus line - Ground
IG switch OFF,
stop light
switch OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
D1-14
(CANL) - D14 (CG)
LOW-level CAN
bus line - Ground
IG switch OFF,
stop light
switch OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
3. SKID CONTROL ECU
(a) Check the skid control ECU harness side connector (S28).
(1) Disconnect the connector (S28) from the skid control
ECU.
(2) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance:
TERMINALS WIRING
TERMINAL
CONDITION SPECIFIED
COLOR DESCRIPTION
VALUE
S28-11
(CANH) S28-25
(CANL)
B-W
HIGH-level
CAN bus line
- LOW-level
CAN bus line
S28-11
(CANH) S28-32
(GND1)
B - W-B
HIGH-level
CAN bus line
- Ground
S28-25
(CANL) S28-32
(GND1)
W - WB
S28-11
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
108 to
132 Ω
3 kΩ or
higher
OFF
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Ground
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
HIGH-level
IG switch
3 kΩ or
higher
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4R...
(CANH) S28-31
(+BS)
S28-25
(CANL) S28-31
(+BS)
B-Y
CAN bus line
- Battery
positive
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
W-Y
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Battery
positive
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
4. STEERING SENSOR
(a) Check the harness side connector (S11) of the steering
sensor.
(1) Disconnect the connector (S11) from the steering
sensor.
(2) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance:
TERMINALS WIRING
TERMINAL
CONDITION SPECIFIED
COLOR DESCRIPTION
VALUE
S11-3
(CANH) S11-11
(CANL)
S11-3
(CANH) S11-2
(ESS)
S11-11
(CANL) S11-2
(ESS)
S11-3
(CANH) S11-9
(BAT)
S11-11
(CANL) S11-9
(BAT)
5. YAW RATE SENSOR
B-Y
HIGH-level
CAN bus line
- LOW-level
CAN bus line
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
108 to
132 Ω
B - W-B
HIGH-level
CAN bus line
- Ground
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
Y - W-B
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Ground
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
B - W-B
HIGH-level
CAN bus line
- Battery
positive
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
Y - W-B
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Battery
positive
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4R...
(a) Check the yaw rate sensor harness side connector (Y1).
(1) Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate
sensor.
(2) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance:
TERMINALS WIRING
TERMINAL
CONDITION SPECIFIED
COLOR DESCRIPTION
VALUE
Y1-3
(CANH) Y1-2
(CANL)
HIGH-level
CAN bus line
- LOW-level
CAN bus line
IG switch
OFF, stop
54 to 69 Ω
light switch
OFF
Y1-3
W - W(CANH) B
Y1-1 (GND)
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Ground
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
Y1-2
(CANL) R - W-B
Y1-1 (GND)
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Ground
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
W-O
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Battery
positive
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
R-O
LOW-level
CAN bus line
- Battery
positive
IG switch
OFF, stop
light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
Y1-3
(CANH) D1-16
(BAT)
Y1-2
(CANL) D1-16
(BAT)
Y-R
6. ECM
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance:
CAN COMMUNICATION: CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM: TERMINALS OF ECU (2007 4R...
TERMINAL
E7-33 (CANH) - E7-34 (CANL)
CONDITION
z
z
SPECIFIED VALUE
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance:
TERMINALS
E7-33 (CANH) E7-34 (CANL)
E7-33 (CANH) E4-7 (E01)
E7-34 (CANL) E4-7 (E01)
E7-33 (CANH) E8-3 (BATT)
E7-34 (CANL) E8-3 (BATT)
WIRING
COLOR
CONDITION
z
L - LG
z
L - W-B
(2UZ-FE)
z
L - BR
(1GR-FE)
z
LG - W-B
(2UZ-FE)
z
LG - BR
(1GR-FE)
z
z
L-L
z
z
LG - L
z
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
SPECIFIED
VALUE
108 to 132
Ω
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
3 kΩ or
higher
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
1 MΩ or
higher
CA–46
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Check CAN Bus Line for Short to GND
DESCRIPTION
A short to GND is suspected in the CAN bus line when there is continuity between terminals 4 (CG) and 6
(CANH) or terminals 4 (CG) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3.
Symptom
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
There is continuity between terminals 4 (CG) and 6 (CANH) or
terminals 4 (CG) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3.
Short to GND in CAN bus line
ECM
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
CAN J/C
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1 Yaw Rate Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
Center J/B
B
3F
B
3F
W-B
CANH
W-B
GND
1
CANL
B
3F
W
1
J48
1
J51
L
R
2
J48
2
J51
LG
3
2
S11 Steering Angle Sensor
CANH
W-B
CA
2
B
1
J49
Y
2
J49
3
ESS
CANL 11
Skid Control ECU
A J15
J/C
A J15
11
CANH S28
25
CANL S28
B
11
IC2
1
B
J47
W
22
IC2
W
32
GND2 S28
2
J47
33 CANH
E7
34
E7
CANL
W-B (2UZ-FE)
7
BR (1GR-FE)
E4 E01
D1
DLC3
1
J50
P
2
J50
V
6
CANH
CANL
14
1
J52
4
W-B
CG
W-B
E
J22
J/C
W-B
W-B
A
A
J24
J/C
II
A
J37
J/C
IK
W-B
E
A
W-B
J5
J/C
IG
J5
J/C
EA
IH
IG
EE
G036696E01
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–47
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (DLC3 SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the DLC3 sub bus line connector (J50) from
the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
P
J50
V
G031933E33
DLC3:
D1
CG
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
G026206E75
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE
OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the DLC3 sub bus line connector (J50) to the
CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–48
3
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
CAN J/C “B” Side (without Earth
Terminal) Wire Harness View:
B
J47
W
G031932E97
DLC3:
D1
CG
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CA
CANL
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
G026206E75
OK
Go to step 10
NG
4
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA–49
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
W
J48
R
G031933E34
DLC3:
D1
CG
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
G026206E75
OK
Go to step 12
NG
6
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–50
7
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS
LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
B
J49
Y
G031933E35
DLC3:
D1
CG
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CA
CANL
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
G026206E75
OK
Go to step 14
NG
8
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
9
CA–51
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (ECM MAIN BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the ECM main bus line connector (J51) from
the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
L
J51
LG
G031933E32
DLC3:
D1
CG
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
G026206E75
OK
Go to step 16
NG
REPLACE CAN J/C
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–52
11
DLC3:
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
D1
CG
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector (S28).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
G026206E75
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
12
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
CA
NEXT
13
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
D1
CG
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector (Y1).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
G026206E75
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
CA–53
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
14
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sub bus line connector
(J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
15
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS
LINE)
D1
CG
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector (S11).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
G026206E75
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
16
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the ECM main bus line connector (J51) to the
CAN J/C.
NEXT
17
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (ECM MAIN BUS LINE)
D1
CG
(a) Disconnect the ECM connector (E7).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
G026206E75
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
REPLACE ECM
CA
CA–54
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ECM MAIN BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
CA
CA–55
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Open in One Side of CAN Sub Bus Line
DESCRIPTION
If 2 or more ECUs and/or sensors do not appear on the intelligent tester's "BUS CHECK" screen via the
CAN VIM, one side of the CAN sub-bus line may be open. (One side of the CAN-H [sub-bus line]/CAN-L
[sub-bus line] of the ECU and/or sensor is open.)
Symptom
Trouble Area
2 or more ECUs and/or sensors do not appear on the
intelligent tester's "BUS CHECK" screen via the CAN VIM.
•
•
•
•
•
•
One side of the CAN sub-bus line is open
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
ECM
CAN J/C
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
CANH
CANL
W
1
J48
1
J51
L
R
2
J48
2
J51
LG
3
2
33
CANH
E7
34
E7
CA
S11
Steering Angle Sensor
CANH
CANL
CANL
Skid Control ECU
B
1
J49
1
J47
B
11
IC2
B
11
S28 CANH
Y
2
J49
2
J47
W
22
IC2
W
25
S28 CANL
P
1
J50
V
2
J50
3
11
D1
DLC3
CANH
CANL
6
14
G036694E01
CA–56
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF CAN SUB BUS LINE (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS
LINE)
CAN J/C “B” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
B
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester via the CAN VIM to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Select "BUS CHECK" on the intelligent tester display via
the CAN VIM (See page CA-13).
Result
J47
Proceed to
W
G031932E98
Result
A
"ABS/VSC/TRAC" does not appear
B
2 or more ECUs and/or sensors do not
appear
A
Go to step 8
B
CA
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
3
CHECK OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF CAN SUB BUS LINE (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB
BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
Earth Terminal
B
J49
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester via the CAN VIM to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Select "BUS CHECK" on the intelligent tester display via
the CAN VIM (See page CA-13).
Result
Proceed to
Y
A
G031933E35
Result
"STEERING SENSOR" does not appear
CA–57
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Proceed to
B
A
Result
2 or more ECUs and/or sensors do not
appear
Go to step 10
B
4
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
5
CHECK OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF CAN SUB BUS LINE (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
Earth Terminal
W
J48
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester via the CAN VIM to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) Select "BUS CHECK" on the intelligent tester display via
the CAN VIM (See page CA-13).
Result
Proceed to
R
G031933E34
B
Result
A
"YAW /DECELERAT" does not appear
B
2 or more ECUs and/or sensors do not
appear
Go to step 12
A
6
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–58
7
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF CAN BUS LINE (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector Front View:
Y1
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector (Y1).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
CANL
Y1-2 (CANL) - Y1-3
(CANH)
G026359E63
NG
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
8
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
9
CHECK OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF CAN SUB BUS LINE (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS
LINE)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front View:
S28
CANH
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector (S28).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
S28-11 (CANH) - S28-25
(CANL)
CANL
E069126E55
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
CA–59
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
11
CHECK OPEN IN ONE SIDE OF CAN SUB BUS LINE (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB
BUS LINE)
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector (S11).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Angle Sensor Wire Harness View:
CANH
Tester connection
S11-3 (CANH) - S11-11
(CANL)
S11
CANL
G027814E07
NG
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE STEERING ANGLE
SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR
(CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
CA
12
CHECK CAN J/C
(a) Disconnect connectors (J47), (J48), (J49), (J50) and
(J51) from the CAN J/C.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal):
CANH
Tester connection
1 (CANH) - 2 (CANL)
CANL
Earth Terminal
CAN J/C “B” Side (without Earth Terminal):
CANH
CANL
G026214E16
NG
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
108 to 132 Ω
REPLACE CAN J/C
CA–60
OK
REPLACE ECM
CA
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–1
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
F045104
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS ON STEERING SYSTEM
(a) Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect
replacement could affect the performance of the
steering system and result in hazardous driving.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS ON SRS AIRBAG
SYSTEM
(a) This vehicle is equipped with an SRS
(Supplemental Restraint System), such as the driver
airbag and front passenger airbag. Failure to carry
out service operation in the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during
servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident.
Before servicing (including removal or installation of
parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read
the precautionary notice for the supplemental
restraint system (See page RS-1).
WIRE HARNESS REPAIR
(a) After repairing the wire bus line with solder, wrap the
repaired part with vinyl tape.
NOTICE:
• The CANL bus line and CANH bus line must
be installed together all the time. When
installing, make sure to twist them.
• The difference in length of the CANL bus line
and CANH bus line should be within 100 mm
(3.93 in.).
• Untwisted parts around the connector should
be within 80 mm (3.15 in.).
(b) Do not perform bypass wiring between the
connectors.
NOTICE:
If you perform bypass wiring, the characteristic
of the twisted wire harness will be lost.
Bypass Wire
F045105E11
4.
F045106
CONNECTOR HANDLING
(a) When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert
them from the back of the connector.
CA
CA–2
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(b) If it is impossible to check resistance from the back
of the connector, use a repair wire to check it.
Repair Wire
F045107E16
CA
CA–15
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
Trouble Mode
Skid control ECU communication stop mode
DTC COMBINATION TABLE
NOTICE:
Complete "CHECK CAN BUS LINE" (See page RS-1)
to confirm that there is no malfunction in the CAN
bus line, and then perform troubleshooting
according to the following DTC combination table.
(a) Confirm the trouble mode according to the
combination of output DTCs.
U0100/65
U0073/94
U0123/62
U0124/95
U0126/63
{
{
{
{
{
Yaw rate sensor communication stop mode
-
-
{
{
-
Steering sensor communication stop mode
-
-
-
-
{
ECM communication stop mode (*2)
{
-
-
-
-
2.
HINT:
• Previous CAN communication system DTCs may
be the cause if CAN communication system
DTCs are output and all ECUs an sensors
connected to the CAN communication system
are displayed on the intelligent tester's "BUS
CHECK" screen via the CAN VIM.
• U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95, U0126/63 and
U0100/65 are the DTCs in the CAN
communication system.
• The above table shows combinations of these
DTCs.
• {..... DTCs that are being output.
• - ...... DTCs that are not being output.
BUS CHECK
HINT:
The ECUs and sensors that are properly connected to
the CAN communication system can be displayed using
the intelligent tester via the CAN VIM.
(a) Select "BUS CHECK" from the "OBD/MOBD
MENU" screen.
G032145
CA
CA–16
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(b) Press "ENTER" on the intelligent tester via the CAN
VIM.
G030152
3.
G032144
DTC No.
CA
(c) The screen displays the ECUs and sensors that are
properly connected to the CAN communication
system.
HINT:
There is a communication stop in the system of any
properly connected ECUs or sensors that are not
displayed (See page CA-7).
DTC TABLE BY ECU
HINT:
If CAN communication system DTCs are output, trouble
cannot be determined only by the DTCs. Perform
troubleshooting according to "HOW TO PROCEED
WITH TROUBLESHOOTING" (See page CA-6).
(a) Skid Control ECU
HINT:
DTC communication uses the SIL line.
Detection Item
U0073/94
Control Module Communication Bus Off
U0100/65
Lost Communication With ECM/PCM "A"
U0123/62
Lost Communication With Yaw Rate Sensor Module
U0124/95
Lost Communication With Lateral Acceleration Sensor Module
U0126/63
Lost Communication With Steering Angle Sensor Module
(b) ECM
HINT:
The ECM is connected to the CAN communication
system but CAN communication system DTCs are
not output.
CA–17
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) When communication fails in any of the CAN bus
lines (communication lines) due to a short circuit or
any other causes, the fail-safe function, which is
specified for each system, operates to prevent the
system from malfunctioning.
(b) This function operates for each system when
communication is impossible. (For further details,
see the pages for each system.)
Function
ECM
Skid Control
ECU
Steering Angle
Sensor
Yaw Rate Sensor
Action when
unable to
communicate
DTC detection
(Driver
detectable)
VSC Control
(Controls VSC/
TRC engine
output)
-
Rx
Tx
Tx
VSC function
stops
Detectable
(Light comes on)
VSC Control
(Controls VSC/
TRC engine
output)
Rx or Tx
Tx or Rx
-
-
VSC function
stops
Detectable
(Light comes on)
HINT:
• Rx: Reception from each ECU (sensor).
• Tx: Transmission to each ECU (sensor).
CA
CA–18
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Skid Control ECU Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
•
SKID CONTROL ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE
•
Trouble Area
"ABS/VSC/TRAC" is not displayed on the "BUS
CHECK" screen of the intelligent tester via the CAN
VIM.
DTCs are output from each ECU in skid control
ECU communication stop mode as shown in the
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE" (See page CA-13).
•
•
Power source or inside the skid control ECU
Skid control ECU sub bus line or connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
CAN J/C
ECM
CANH
CANL
33
E7
L
1
J51
1
J47
B
11
IC2
B
11
S28 CANH
34
E7
LG
2
J51
2
J47
W
22
IC2
W
25
S28 CANL
Driver Side J/B
CA
L-Y
ECU-IG
2
1C
J4
J/C
12
1E
B-R
F
W-L
AM1 2
F
46
S28 IG1
Engine Room R/B
I18
Ignition SW
4 IG1
B-R
ALT
AM1
2
2
1
2
1
2
B
2
2
32
S28 GND2
B
W-B
Battery
EA
G036690E01
CA–19
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front View:
S28
CANH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector (S28).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
S28-11 (CANH) - S28-25
(CANL)
CANL
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
E069126E55
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IG, GND2)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front View:
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
S28
IG1
GND2
E069126E56
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S28-32 (GND2) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S28-46 (IG1) - Body
ground
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
CA
CA–20
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Steering Angle Sensor Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
•
STEERING ANGLE
SENSOR
COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE
Trouble Area
"STEERING SENSOR" is not displayed on the
"BUS CHECK" screen of the intelligent tester via
the CAN VIM.
DTCs are output from each ECU in steering angle
sensor communication stop mode as shown in the
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE" (See page CA-13).
•
•
•
Power source or inside the steering angle sensor
Steering angle sensor sub bus line or connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
S11
Steering Angle Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
CANH
CANL
33
E7
L
34
E7
LG
1
J51
1
J49
B
2
J51
2
J49
Y
3
11
CANH
CANL
Driver Side J/B
ECU-IG
2
1C
CA
J20
J/C
28
1J
B-R
A
J12
B-R
G
G
J/C
A
J13
B-R
A
J15
W-B
1
IG1
I18 Ignition SW
L-Y
A
J15
W-L
4 IG1
AM1 2
J/C
2
ESS
Engine Room R/B
ALT
2
B
2
1
AM1
2
1
2
W-B
2
2
B
A
J5
J/C
Battery
IG
G036691E01
CA–21
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS
LINE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector (S11).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Angle Sensor Wire Harness View:
CANH
Tester connection
S11-3 (CANH) - S11-11
(CANL)
S11
CANL
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
G027814E07
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STEERING ANGLE
SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR
(CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IG1, ESS)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Steering Angle Sensor Wire Harness View:
ESS
IG1
S11
G027814E08
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S11-2 (ESS) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S11-1 (IG1) - Body
ground
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
CA
CA–22
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Yaw Rate Sensor Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
•
YAW RATE SENSOR
COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE
Trouble Area
"YAW/DECELERAT" is not displayed on the "BUS
CHECK" screen of the intelligent tester via the CAN
VIM.
DTCs are output from each ECU in yaw rate sensor
communication stop mode as shown in the "DTC
COMBINATION TABLE" (See page CA-13).
•
•
•
Power source or inside the yaw rate sensor
Yaw rate sensor sub bus line or connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
CANH
CANL
33
E7
L
34
E7
LG
1
J51
1
J48
W
2
J51
2
J48
R
3
2
CANH
CANL
Driver Side J/B
ECU-IG
2
1C
CA
28
1J
J20
J/C
B-R
G
A
J12
B-R
G
J/C
A
J12
B-R
B
3F
W-B
5
IG1
Center J/B
I18 Ignition SW
L-Y
B
3F
W-L
4 IG1
AM1 2
ALT
B
2
1
GND
B
3F
Engine Room R/B
2
1
AM1
2 1
2
2
W-B
2
W-B
B
A
A
J24
J/C
J37
J/C
Battery
II
IK
G036692E01
CA–23
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector Front View:
Y1
CANH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector (Y1).
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANL
Tester connection
Y1-2 (CANL) - Y1-3
(CANH)
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
G026359E63
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IG, GND)
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector Front View:
Y1
GND
IG
G026359E64
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Y1-1 (GND) - Body
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Y1-5 (IG) - Body ground
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
CA
CA–24
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CAN Bus Line
DESCRIPTION
When any DTC of the CAN communication system is output, first measure the resistance between the
terminals of the DLC3 and the yaw rate sensor connector to specify the trouble area.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
CANH
CANL
W
1
J48
1
J51
L
R
2
J48
2
J51
LG
3
2
33
CANH
E7
34
E7
Skid Control ECU
S11 Steering Angle Sensor
CANH
CANL
CANL
B
1
J49
1
J47
B
11
IC2
B
11
S28 CANH
Y
2
J49
2
J47
W
22
IC2
W
25
S28 CANL
3
11
D1
DLC3
CA
1
J50
P
2
J50
V
6
14
CANH
CANL
Engine Room R/B
ALT
2
B
2
1
OBD
2
1
2
2
C14
IC4
O
O
16
BAT
J22
J/C
2
W-B
B
W-B
E
E
4
CG
A
J5
J/C
Battery
IG
G036689E01
CA–25
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS WIRE (MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION, BUS LINES FOR
SHORT CIRCUIT)
D1
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester
connection
Condition
•
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
CANL
•
•
G026206E73
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
•
•
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
•
Specified value
Result
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
69 Ω or higher
NG-A
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
Below 54 Ω
NG-B
NG-A
CHECK CAN MAIN BUS LINE FOR
DISCONNECTION
NG-B
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT
CIRCUIT
OK
2
DLC3:
CA
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B
D1
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
BAT
CANL
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
G026206E74
NG
OK
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B
CA–26
3
DLC3:
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
D1
CG
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
CANL
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
3 kΩ or higher
G026206E75
NG
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
OK
GO TO HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
CA
Condition
•
•
CA–27
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CAN Main Bus Line for Disconnection
DESCRIPTION
The CAN main bus line and DLC3 sub bus line may have a disconnection when the resistance between
terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3 is more than 69 Ω.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the
DLC3 is more than 69 Ω.
•
•
•
CAN main bus line
ECM
CAN J/C
WIRING DIAGRAM
D1
DLC3
CANH
CAN J/C
P
6
1
J50
ECM
1
J51
L
33
CANH
E7
CA
CANL
V
14
2
J50
2
J51
LG
34
E7
CANL
G036693E01
CA–28
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
DLC3:
CHECK DLC3
D1
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Result
CANH
Tester
connection
Condition
•
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
CANL
•
•
G026206E73
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
•
Specified value
Result
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
A
IG switch
OFF
Stop light
switch OFF
132 Ω or higher
B
NOTICE:
When the measured value is 132 Ω or more and a
CAN communication system diagnostic code is
output, there may be a fault other than a
disconnection of the DLC3 sub bus line. For that
reason, troubleshooting should be performed again
from "How to Proceed with Troubleshooting" after
repairing the trouble area.
B
CA
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE
OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
A
2
CHECK CAN MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (ECM - CAN J/C)
(a) Disconnect the connector (E7) from the ECM.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
ECM Wire Harness View:
Tester connection
E7-33 (CANH) - E7-34
(CANL)
E7
CANL
NG
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
108 to 132 Ω
CANH
G038051E01
OK
REPLACE ECM
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
CA–29
CHECK CAN J/C
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the CAN main bus line connector (J51) from
the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
L
J51
LG
G031933E32
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal):
CANH
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Between the terminals
where the connector
(J51) was connected
CANH - CANL
CANL
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
108 to 132 Ω
G026370E04
NG
REPLACE CAN J/C
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN BUS MAIN WIRE OR CONNECTOR (CAN J/C - ECM)
CA
CA–30
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Check CAN Bus Lines for Short Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The CAN bus lines are considered to be shorted when the resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14
(CANL) of the DLC3 is below 54 Ω.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the
DLC3 is below 54 Ω.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Short in CAN bus lines
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
ECM
CAN J/C
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
CANH
CANL
CA
W
1
J48
1
J51
L
R
2
J48
2
J51
LG
3
2
33
CANH
E7
34
E7
S11
Steering Angle Sensor
CANH
CANL
CANL
Skid Control ECU
B
1
J49
1
J47
B
11
IC2
B
11
S28 CANH
Y
2
J49
2
J47
W
22
IC2
W
25
S28 CANL
P
1
J50
V
2
J50
3
11
D1
DLC3
CANH
CANL
6
14
G036694E01
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–31
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (DLC3 SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the DLC3 sub bus line connector (J50) from
the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
P
J50
V
G031933E33
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
NG
G026206E73
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or more
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE
OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the DLC3 sub bus line connector (J50) to the
CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–32
3
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
CAN J/C “B” Side (without Earth
Terminal) Wire Harness View:
B
J47
W
G031932E97
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CA
CANL
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
Go to step 10
G026206E73
NG
4
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5
CA–33
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
W
J48
R
G031933E34
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
Go to step 12
G026206E73
NG
6
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–34
7
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS
LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
B
J49
Y
G031933E35
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CA
CANL
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
Go to step 14
G026206E73
NG
8
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
9
CA–35
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (ECM MAIN BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the ECM main bus line connector (J51) from
the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
L
J51
LG
G031933E32
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
108 to 132 Ω
Go to step 16
G026206E73
NG
REPLACE CAN J/C
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–36
11
DLC3:
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector (S28).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
G026206E73
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
12
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
13
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector (Y1).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
G026206E73
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR
14
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA–37
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
15
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS
LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector (S11).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
G026206E73
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
16
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the ECM main bus line connector (J51) to the
CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
17
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (ECM MAIN BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the ECM connector (E7).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
CANL
G026206E73
OK
•
•
Condition
Specified value
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
108 to 132 Ω
REPLACE ECM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ECM MAIN BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
CA–38
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Check CAN Bus Line for Short to +B
DESCRIPTION
A short to +B is suspected in the CAN bus line when there is continuity between terminals 16 (BAT) and 6
(CANH) or terminals 16 (BAT) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3.
Symptom
There is continuity between terminals 16 (BAT) and 6 (CANH) or 16
(BAT) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3.
CA
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Short to +B in CAN bus line
ECM
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
CA–39
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
S11 Steering Angle Sensor
CAN J/C
ECM
Center J/B
B
3E
W-R
CANH
B
3E
W-R
9
CANL
4
1B
1
J49
1
J51
L
Y
2
J49
2
J51
LG
3
BAT
Driver Side J/B
4
1L
B
11
33
CANH
E7
34
E7
3
E8 BATT
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
W-R
W
1
J48
R
2
J48
11
IC2
B
1
J47
1
J50
P
22
IC2
W
2
J47
2
J50
V
CANH
Skid Control ECU
3
CANL 2
11
CANH S28
B
25
CANL S28
W
31
S28 +BS
CANL
D1
DLC3
6
14
L
CANH
CANL
BAT
O
16
Y
Engine Room R/B
CA
ECU-B
2
Short Pin
1
2
B
1
2
W
2
2
OBD
ALT
2
1
2
1
2
O
2
C14
IC4
2
B
ABS SOL
2
1
2
2
EF1
1
2
2
Y
L
C4
IC4
Battery
G036695E01
CA–40
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (DLC3 SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the DLC3 sub bus line connector (J50) from
the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
P
J50
V
G031933E33
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
BAT
CA
CANL
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
G026206E74
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE
OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the DLC3 sub bus line connector (J50) to the
CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA–41
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
CAN J/C “B” Side (without Earth
Terminal) Wire Harness View:
B
J47
W
G031932E97
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
BAT
CANL
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
G026206E74
OK
Go to step 10
NG
4
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA
CA–42
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
W
J48
R
G031933E34
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
BAT
CA
CANL
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
G026206E74
OK
Go to step 12
NG
6
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA–43
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
7
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
CAN J/C “A” Side (with Earth Terminal)
Wire Harness View:
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) from the CAN J/C.
NOTICE:
• Before disconnecting the connector, make a note
of where it is connected.
• Reconnect the connector to its original position.
Earth Terminal
B
J49
Y
G031933E35
DLC3:
D1
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
BAT
CANL
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
CA
G026206E74
OK
Go to step 14
NG
8
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
9
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (ECM MAIN BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the ECM connector (E7).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
BAT
CANL
G026206E74
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CA–44
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE ECM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ECM MAIN BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the skid control ECU sub bus line connector
(J47) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
11
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector (S28).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
BAT
CANL
G026206E74
CA
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
REPLACE MASTER CYLINDER SOLENOID
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
12
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the yaw rate sensor sub bus line connector
(J48) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
CA–45
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
13
DLC3:
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector (Y1).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
BAT
CANL
G026206E74
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
14
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the steering angle sensor sub bus line
connector (J49) to the CAN J/C.
NEXT
15
DLC3:
CA
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector (S11).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester connection
BAT
CANL
G026206E74
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-6
(CANH)
D1-16 (BAT) - D1-14
(CANL)
OK
Condition
Specified value
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
•
•
IG switch OFF
Stop light switch
OFF
1 MΩ or higher
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRS002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
(a) Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell (Maintenance-Free Battery).
(1) If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add distilled water if possible) and check the
charging system.
(b) Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell (Except Maintenance-Free Battery).
(1) If under the lower level, add distilled water.
2. CHECK BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY
(a) Except Maintenance-Free Battery:
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity:
1.25 to 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
If the specific gravity is less than specification, charge the
battery.
3. CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) After having driven the vehicle and in the case that 20
minutes have not passed after having stopped the
engine, turn the ignition switch ON and turn on the
electrical system (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger
etc.) for 60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF and turn off the electrical systems.
(c) Measure the battery voltage between the negative (-) and positive (+) terminals of the battery.
Standard voltage:
12.5 to 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
HINT:
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the battery.
(d) Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
z
z
z
Blue: OK
White: Charging Necessary
Red: Insufficient Water
4. CHECK BATTERY TERMINAL
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or corroded.
5. CHECK FUSIBLE LINK AND FUSES
(a) Check the fusible link, H-fuses and fuses for continuity.
6. INSPECT FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed cords
etc.
HINT:
z
z
If any defect has been found, replace the fan and
generator V belt.
Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered
acceptable. If the belt has chunks missing from the ribs,
it should be replaced.
(b) Check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
HINT:
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has not slipped
out of the groove on the bottom of the pulley.
7. VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING
(a) Check that the wiring is in good condition.
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
8. LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES FROM GENERATOR
(a) Check that there is no abnormal noise from the generator while the engine is running.
9. INSPECT CHARGE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. Check that the charge warning light comes on.
(b) Start the engine. Check that the light goes off.
HINT:
If the light does not operate as specified, troubleshoot the charge warning light circuit.
10. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
(a) If a battery/generator tester is available, connect the tester to the charging circuit as per
manufacturer's instructions.
(b) If a tester is not available, connect a voltmeter to the
charging circuit as follows.
(1) Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the generator
and connect it to the negative (-) lead of the
ammeter.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead of the ammeter to
terminal B of the generator.
(3) Connect the positive (+) lead of the voltmeter to
terminal B of the generator.
(4) Ground the negative (-) lead of the voltmeter.
(c) Check the charging circuit.
(1) With the engine running from idle to 2,000 rpm, check the reading on the ammeter and
voltmeter.
Standard amperage:
10 A or less
Standard voltage:
13.2 to 14.8 V
HINT:
z
z
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage, replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than the standard voltage, check the voltage regulator and
generator as follows:
11. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the high beam headlights and place the heater
blower switch at "HI".
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Standard amperage:
30 A or more
HINT:
z
z
If the ammeter reading is less than standard amperage, repair the generator.
If the battery is fully charged, the indication will sometimes be less than standard amperage.
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 R
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRR002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
PARTS LOCATION
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 L
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BSC002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: CHARGING SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
PRECAUTION
1. PRECAUTION
(a) Check that the battery cables are connected to the correct terminals.
(b) Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is given a quick charge.
(c) Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation resistance tester.
(d) Never disconnect the battery while the engine is running.
(e) Check that the charging cable is tightened on terminal B of the generator and the fuse box.
(f) Do not perform inspection of the generator in which terminal F is connected to the other terminal.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002BSD002X
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRW002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE GENERATOR PULLEY
SST: 09820-63010
09820-06010
09820-06020
SST 1-A and B
09820-06010
SST 2
09820-06020
(a) Hold SST 1-A with a torque wrench, and tighten SST 1-B
clockwise with the specified torque.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that SST is secured to the rotor shaft.
(b) Mount SST 2 in a vise.
(c) Insert SST 1-A and B into SST 2, and attach the pulley nut to SST 2.
(d) To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST 1-A in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not loosen the
pulley nut more than one-half turn.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(e) Remove the generator from SST 2.
(f) Turn SST 1-B, and remove SST 1-A and B.
(g) Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
2. REMOVE GENERATOR REAR END COVER
(a) Place the generator on the pulley.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and rear end cover.
3. REMOVE TERMINAL INSULATOR
(a) Remove the terminal insulator.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
4. REMOVE GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the plate seal.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and brush holder.
(c) Remove the plate seal.
5. REMOVE GENERATOR COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Using SST, remove the coil.
SST: 09950-40011
09951-04020
09952-04010
09953-04020
09954-04010
09955-04071
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
09957-04010
09958-04011
6. REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the washer and rotor.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRU002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed brush length:
10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed brush length:
4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
If the exposed brush length is less than minimum,
replace the brush holder.
2. INSPECT GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the rotor open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the slip rings.
Resistance:
2.3 to 2.7 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the rotor.
(b) Check the rotor ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the slip ring and rotor.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor.
(c) Inspect slip rings.
(1) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(2) Using vernier calipers, measure the slip ring
diameter.
Standard diameter:
14.2 to 14.4 (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter:
14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the
rotor.
3. INSPECT GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Check the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
4. REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and
bearing.
SST: 09820-00021
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (Inside).
5. INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Place the rotor on the pulley.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Install the bearing cover (Inside).
(c) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST: 09820-00031
(d) Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST: 09285-76010
6. INSPECT GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
(a) Check the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
7. REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
(a) Remove the 4 screws and retainer plate.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using SST, tap out the bearing.
SST: 09950-60010
09951-00250
SST: 09950-70010
09951-07100
8. INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST: 09950-60010
09951-00470
SST: 09950-70010
09951-07100
(b) Install the retainer plate with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.6 N·m (27 kgf·cm, 23 in·lbf)
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRT002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the generator assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (438 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(b) Install the wire harness clamp bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in·lbf)
(c) Connect the wire harness.
(1) Connect the wire harness to the terminal B and install the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(2) Connect the connector to the generator assembly.
(3) Install the wire harness stay with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in·lbf)
2. INSTALL BATTERY
3. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
4. INSTALL ENGINE NO. 1 UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1 with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
5. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRX002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
REASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the drive end frame on the rotor.
(b) Install the rotor and washer.
2. INSTALL GENERATOR COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and a press, press in the coil carefully.
SST: 09285-76010
(b) Install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 5.8 N·m (59 kgf·cm, 51 in·lbf)
3. INSTALL GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the plate seal (Inside).
(b) Place the brush holder with the pin facing upward.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the brush holder installing direction.
(c) Install the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.8 N·m (18 kgf·cm, 16 in·lbf)
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(d) Align the pins of the brush holder with the holes of the plate seal (outside), and install the plate
seal (outside).
4. INSTALL TERMINAL INSULATOR
5. INSTALL GENERATOR REAR END COVER
(a) Install the rear end cover with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 4.6 N·m (47 kgf·cm, 41 in·lbf)
6. INSTALL GENERATOR PULLEY
SST: 09820-63010
09820-06010
09820-06020
SST 1-A and B
09820-06010
SST 2
09820-06020
(a) Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the
pulley nut by hand.
(b) Hold SST 1-A with a torque wrench, and tighten SST 1-B clockwise with the specified torque.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that SST is secured to the rotor shaft.
(c) Mount SST 2 in a vise.
(d) Insert SST 1-A and B into SST 2, and attach the pulley nut to SST 2
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(e) Tighten the pulley nut by turning SST 1-A in the
direction shown in the illustration.
Torque: 111 N·m (1,125 kgf·cm, 81 ft·lbf)
(f) Remove the generator from SST 2.
(g) Turn SST 1-B, and remove SST 1-A, B.
(h) Turn the pulley, and check that the pulley moves smoothly.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Power Source/Network
Section: Battery/Charging
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BRV002X
Title: 1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
2. REMOVE ENGINE NO. 1 UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover sub-assembly No. 1.
3. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
4. REMOVE BATTERY
5. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the wire harness.
(1) Remove the bolt and wire harness stay.
(2) Disconnect the connector from the generator
assembly.
(3) Remove the terminal cap and nut.
(4) Disconnect the wire harness from the terminal B.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and wire harness clamp bracket
from the generator assembly.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and generator assembly.
1GR-FE CHARGING: GENERATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: COOLANT: REPLACEMENT (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017DS009X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: COOLANT: REPLACEMENT (2007 4Runner)
REPLACEMENT
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Thermal expansion will cause hot engine coolant and steam to blow out
from the radiator.
(a) Remove the service hole cover from the engine under
cover.
(b) Install a vinyl hose onto the drain on the radiator side.
(c) Fix the vinyl hose with tape.
(d) Loosen the 3 drain plugs on the engine and radiator,
and drain the coolant.
(e) Remove the radiator cap.
(f) Drain the coolant from the reservoir tank.
(g) Tighten the 3 drain plugs.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(h) Remove the vinyl hose from the radiator.
2. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
1GR-FE COOLING: COOLANT: REPLACEMENT (2007 4Runner)
(a) Slowly fill the system with engine coolant.
Capacity:
9.8 liters (10.4 Us qts, 8.6 Imp. qts)
HINT:
z
z
z
z
Use of improper coolants may damage the engine cooling system.
Use only Toyota Super Long Life Coolant or similar high quality ethylene glycol based non-silicate,
non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology
(coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology consists of a combination of low phosphates
and organic acids).
New Toyota vehicles are filled with Toyota Super Long Life Coolant (color is pink, premixed
ethylene glycol concentration is approximately 50 % and freezing temperature is -35°C (-31°F)).
When replacing the coolant, Toyota Super Long Life Coolant is recommended.
Observe the coolant level inside the radiator by pressing the inlet and outlet radiator hoses several
times by hand. If the coolant level goes down, add the coolant.
NOTICE:
Do not substitute plain water for engine coolant.
(b) Install the radiator cap securely.
(c) Bleed the cooling system.
(1) Open the heater water valve while warming up the engine.
(2) Maintain the engine speed at 2,000 to 2,500 rpm and warm up the engine.
(d) Stop the engine and wait until the coolant cools down.
(e) Add coolant into the reservoir until the coolant level is FULL.
3. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(b) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm 2 17.1 psi), then check for leakage.
1GR-FE COOLING: COOLING SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BGY006X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: COOLING SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT FLUID COUPLING ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the fluid coupling for damage or silicon oil leaks.
If necessary, replace the fluid coupling.
1GR-FE COOLING: COOLING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000V1Q027X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: COOLING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKAGE
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Thermal expansion will cause hot engine coolant and steam to blow out
from the radiator.
(b) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap
tester.
(c) Warm up the engine.
(d) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm 2, 17.1 psi), then check that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator and water pump for leakage. If there are no signs
of external coolant leakage, check the heater core, cylinder block and cylinder head.
(e) Reinstall the radiator cap.
2. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
(a) The engine coolant should be between the LOW and FULL lines when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leakage and add Toyota Super Long Life Coolant or similar high quality ethylene
glycol based non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid
organic acid technology up to the FULL line.
3. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Thermal expansion will cause hot engine coolant and steam to blow out
from the radiator.
(b) Check for any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap and radiator filler hole;
1GR-FE COOLING: COOLING SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
the coolant should be free of oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002BGH006X
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BGG007X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the tabs of the radiator support through the
radiator service holes.
(b) Install the radiator assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 18 N·m (184 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
2. INSTALL FAN SHROUD
(a) Insert the tabs in the slots shown in the illustration,
attach the fan shroud with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (51 kgf·cm, 44 in·lbf)
3. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
4. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: ON-VEHICLE CLEANING (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 N
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000V1Y01MX
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: ON-VEHICLE CLEANING (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE CLEANING
1. INSPECT FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
(a) If the fins are clogged, wash them with water or a steam cleaner, then dry them with compressed
air.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
If the distance between the steam cleaner and core is too small, there is a possibility of damaging
the fins, so keep to the following injection distances.
INJECTION PRESSURE KPA (KG/CM 2, PSI)
INJECTION DISTANCE MM (IN.)
2,942 to 4,903 (30 to 50, 427 to 711)
300 (11.811)
4,903 to 7,845 (50 to 80, 711 to 1,138)
500 (19.685)
If the fins are bent, straighten them with a screwdriver or pliers.
Be careful not to expose electronic components to water.
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000XYW023X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RADIATOR CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
If the radiator cap is contaminated, rinse it with water.
Before using a radiator cap tester, wet the relief valve and pressure valve with engine coolant or
water.
When performing the following steps [A} and [B], keep the tester at an angle of 30° or more
above the horizontal.
z
z
z
(a) Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump and check that
air comes from the vacuum valve [A].
Pumping speed:
1 push every 3 seconds or more
NOTICE:
Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air does not come from the vacuum valve, replace the
reservoir cap.
(b) Pump the tester, then measure the relief valve opening pressure [B].
Pumping speed:
1 push every second
NOTICE:
The above pumping speed is for the first pumping only (in order to close the vacuum valve).
After the first pumping, the pumping speed can be reduced.
HINT:
Use the tester's maximum reading as the opening pressure.
Standard opening pressure:
93 to 123 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf*cm 2, 13.5 to 17.8 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
78 kPa (0.8 kgf*cm 2, 11.4 psi)
If the opening pressure is less than the minimum, replace the radiator cap.
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BGI007X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support upper.
3. SEPARATE FAN SHROUD
(a) Disconnect the reserve tank hose from the radiator.
(b) Disconnect the radiator hose No. 1 from the radiator.
(c) Disconnect the oil cooler inlet hose from the radiator.
(d) Disconnect the oil cooler outlet hose from the radiator.
(e) Disconnect the radiator hose No. 2 from the radiator.
(f) Remove the 3 bolts, and separate the fan shroud.
HINT:
Temporarily put the separated fan shroud at an appropriate
location in the engine room.
4. REMOVE RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE COOLING: RADIATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and radiator.
5. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT NO.1
(a) Remove the 1 radiator support No. 1.
6. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT NO.2
(a) Remove the 3 radiator support No. 2.
7. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT NO.1 BUSH
(a) Remove the 4 radiator support No. 1 bush.
1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002BG7002X
1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000V1K00RX
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT WATER INLET WITH THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The valve opening temperature is inscribed on the thermostat.
(a) Immerse the thermostat in water, then gradually heat
the water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
Valve opening temperature:
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified, replace the thermostat.
(c) Check the valve lift.
Valve lift:
8.0 mm (0.31 in.) or more at 95°C (203°F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the
1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the thermostat is at low temperature (below 40°C (104°
F)).
If not fully closed, replace the thermostat.
1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BG9002X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL WATER INLET WITH THERMOSTAT
(a) Install a new gasket to the water inlet with thermostat.
(b) Install the water inlet with thermostat with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
2. CONNECT RADIATOR OUTLET, NO.2 HOSE CLAMP OR CLIP
3. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
4. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK
5. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BG8002X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: THERMOSTAT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
HINT:
If the thermostat was not installed, cooling efficiency would be harmed. Even if the engine tends to
overheat, do not remove the thermostat.
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
3. DISCONNECT RADIATOR OUTLET, NO.2 HOSE CLAMP OR CLIP
4. REMOVE WATER INLET WITH THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the 3 nuts, water inlet with thermostat and
gasket.
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002BG4002X
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000V1G00PX
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check the air hole and water hole for coolant
leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump assembly.
(b) Turn the pulley and check that the water pump bearing moves smoothly and quietly.
If necessary, replace the water pump assembly.
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BG2002X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 17 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 23 N·m (235 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
2. INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
3. INSTALL COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
4. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
5. INSTALL NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 idler pulleys with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (398 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
6. INSTALL WATER INLET
(a) Install a new O-ring to the water outlet pipe.
(b) Install a new gasket to the water pump.
(c) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
(d) Install the water inlet with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(e) Connect the 5 water by-pass hoses.
(f) Connect the 2 radiator hoses.
(g) Connect the 2 oil cooler hoses (with oil cooler).
7. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
8. CONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
9. INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Put the fan pulley to the water pump.
(b) Put the fan with fluid coupling and fan shroud together.
(c) Temporarily install the 4 fluid coupling nuts.
(d) Tighten the 2 fan shroud bolts and radiator reserve tank bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (51 kgf·cm, 44 in·lbf)
(e) Connect the reserve tank hose.
(f) Fasten the 2 oil cooler hoses with the hose clamp.
10. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
11. FULLY TIGHTEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Tighten the 4 fluid coupling bolts.
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
13. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
14. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK
15. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
16. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the engine under cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Cooling
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BG5002X
Title: 1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover.
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
4. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support seal upper.
5. LOOSEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Loosen the 4 fluid coupling bolts.
6. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
7. REMOVE FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Unfasten the hose clamp, and then separate the 2 oil
cooler hoses from the fan shroud.
(b) Disconnect the radiator reserve tank hose.
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(c) Remove the 2 fan shroud bolts and radiator reserve tank bolt.
(d) Remove the 4 fluid coupling nuts, and then remove the fan with fluid coupling and fan shroud
together.
(e) Remove the fan pulley.
8. DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
9. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
10. REMOVE WATER INLET
(a) Disconnect the 2 oil cooler hoses (with oil cooler).
(b) Disconnect the 2 radiator hoses.
(c) Disconnect the 5 water by-pass hoses.
1GR-FE COOLING: WATER PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(d) Remove the 5 bolts and water inlet.
(e) Remove the O-ring from the water outlet pipe.
(f) Remove the gasket from the water pump.
11. REMOVE NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 idler pulleys.
12. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
13. SEPARATE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
14. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
15. REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 17 bolts, water pump and gasket.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292S002X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (for Bank 1 and Bank 2)
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
TERMINAL NO.
RESISTANCE
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 2°C (68°F)
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
No continuity
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292Q001X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292P001X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the charcoal canister with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 20 N·m (204 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the purge line hose to the charcoal canister.
(c) Connect the connector to the pump module.
(d) Connect the canister outlet hose No. 2 to the charcoal canister.
(e) Connect the fuel tank hose to the charcoal canister.
2. INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER NO. 2 FILTER
(a) Install the charcoal canister with a bolt.
Torque: 20 N·m (204 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the canister outlet hose to the fuel tank filler pipe.
(c) Connect the canister outlet hose No. 2 to the charcoal canister.
3. INSTALL SPARE TIRE
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292R001X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE SPARE TIRE
2. REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER NO. 2 FILTER
(a) Disconnect the canister outlet hose No. 2 from the
charcoal canister.
(1) Deeply push the connector inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(b) Disconnect the canister outlet hose from the fuel tank filler pipe.
(c) Remove a bolt and the charcoal canister filter.
3. REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose from the charcoal
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: CANISTER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
canister.
(1) Deeply push the connector inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(b) Disconnect the canister outlet hose No. 2 from the charcoal canister.
(1) Deeply push the connector inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the pump module.
(d) Disconnect the purge line hose from the charcoal canister.
(e) Remove the 3 bolts and the charcoal canister from the body.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION ...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292O002X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007
4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT AIR-FUEL RATIO COMPENSATION SYSTEM
(a) Measure voltage between terminals of the ECM.
Standard voltage:
TERMINAL
CONDITION
VOLTAGE
A1A+ ←→ E1
IG switch ON
3.3 V
A1A- ←→ E1
IG switch ON
3.0 V
A2A+ ←→ E1
IG switch ON
3.3 V
A2A- ←→ E1
IG switch ON
3.0 V
CAUTION:
Connect test leads from the back side of the ECM connector.
HINT:
Voltage between terminals of the ECM is kept constant regardless of the voltage of A/F sensor.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Select "DATA MONITOR" - "A/FS B1 S1", "A/FS B2 S1" and "O2S B1 S2" to display the monitor.
(d) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine speed at 2, 500 rpm for approx. 2 minutes.
(e) Keep the engine speed at 2,500 rpm and confirm that
the displays of "A/FS B1 S1" and "A/FS B2 S1" are similar
to the illustration on the left.
CAUTION:
The illustration differs from the real display.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION ...
HINT:
Only intelligent tester displays the waveform of A/F sensor.
(f) Confirm that the displays of "O2S B1 S2" changes between 0 V to 1 V with the engine speed at
2,500 rpm.
2. INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF RPM
(a) Increase the engine speed to at least 3,500 rpm.
(b) Use a sound scope to check for injector operating noise.
(c) Check that when the throttle lever is released, injector operation noise stops momentarily and then
resumes.
Fuel cut off rpm:
2,500 rpm
Fuel return rpm:
1,200 rpm
3. VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND GASKETS
(a) Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
HINT:
Separation of the engine oil dipstick, oil filter cap, PCV hose,
etc. may causes an engine failure or engine malfunctions.
Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of the air
induction system between the throttle body and cylinder head
will allow air suction and cause an engine failure or engine
malfunctions.
4. CHECK AIR TIGHTNESS IN FUEL TANK AND FILLER PIPE
(a) Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank
.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION ...
(b) Apply pressure to the fuel tank and make the internal pressure of the air pressure 4 kPa (41 gf/cm
2
, 0.58 psi).
(c) Check that the internal pressure in the fuel tank is maintained for 1 minute.
(d) Check the connections for each hose and pipe.
(e) Check the installed parts on the fuel tank. If there is no abnormality, replace the fuel tank and filler
pipe.
(f) Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
5. INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF VALVE AND FILL CHECK VALVE
(a) Fill the fuel tank with fuel enough.
(b) Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank
.
2
(c) Apply 4 kPa (41 gf/cm , 0.58 psi) to the vent port of the fuel tank.
(d) Remove the fuel tank cap, and check that the pressure inside the tank drops.
If pressure does not drop, replace the fuel tank assembly.
(e) Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION ...
6. CHECK AIR INLET LINE
(a) Disconnect the air inlet line hose from the charcoal
canister
.
(b) Check that there is ventilation in the air inlet line.
(c) Reconnect the air inlet line hose to the charcoal canister.
7. INSPECT VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Inspect the power source voltage of the vapor pressure
sensor.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between
connector terminals VC and E2 on the wiring harness
side of the ECM.
Voltage:
4.5 to 5.5 V
(3) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Inspect the power output of the vapor pressure sensor.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Remove the fuel tank cap.
(3) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between
connector terminals PTNK and E2 on the wiring
harness side of the ECM.
Voltage:
3.0 to 3.6 V
(4) Reinstall the fuel tank cap.
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4R...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 R
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292N002X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
PARTS LOCATION
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4R...
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4R...
1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Emission Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000292T002X
Title: 1GR-FE EMISSION CONTROL: HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1 and Bank 2)
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
the terminals.
Resistance:
TERMINAL NO.
RESISTANCE
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 (HT) - 4 (E1)
No Continuity
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BR6002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BR5002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Align the mark link (yellow) with the timing mark (1-dot
mark) of the camshaft timing gear as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portions and journals of the camshafts.
(c) Temporarily put the No. 1 chain on the No. 2 chain of
the camshaft timing gear.
(d) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing gear
with the knock pin of the No. 1 camshaft, and insert the
No. 1 camshaft into the camshaft timing gear.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(e) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
(f) Set the No. 1 camshaft onto the RH cylinder head with
the cam lobes of the No. 1 cylinder facing downward as
shown in the illustration.
(g) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(i) Using several steps, install and tighten the 8 bearing cap
bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(j) Rotate the No. 1 camshaft clockwise using a wrench so
that the timing mark of the camshaft timing gear is
aligned with the timing mark of the camshaft bearing
cap.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(k) Align the paint mark of the No. 1 chain with the timing
mark of the camshaft timing gear.
(l) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 1 camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
2. INSTALL NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0 mm
(0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear and No. 2
chain tensioner and align the mark links (yellow) with
the timing marks (1-dot mark) of the camshaft timing
gears.
(c) Tighten the No. 2 chain tensioner bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
3. INSTALL NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Set the No. 2 camshaft onto the RH cylinder head with
the cam lobes of the No. 1 cylinder facing upward as
shown in the illustration.
(b) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(d) Using several steps, install and tighten the 8 bearing cap
bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(e) Rotate the No. 2 camshaft clockwise using a wrench so
that the knock pin of the No. 2 camshaft is aligned with
the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing gear.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(f) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 2 camshaft with a
wrench, and install the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(g) Remove the pin from the No. 2 chain tensioner.
4. INSTALL NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Align the mark link (yellow) with the timing mark (2-dot
mark) of the camshaft timing gear as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portions and journals of the camshafts.
(c) Temporarily put the No. 1 chain on the No. 2 chain of
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
the camshaft timing gear.
(d) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing gear
with the knock pin of the No. 3 camshaft, and insert the
No. 3 camshaft into the camshaft timing gear.
(e) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
(f) Set the No. 3 camshaft onto the LH cylinder head with
the cam lobes of the No. 2 cylinder facing downward as
shown in the illustration.
(g) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(i) Using several steps, install and tighten the 8 bearing cap
bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(j) Set the paint mark of the No. 1 chain between the timing
marks of the camshaft timing gear.
(k) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 3 camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
5. INSTALL NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0 mm
(0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear and No. 3
chain tensioner and align the mark links (yellow) with
the timing marks (1-dot mark and 2-dot mark) of the
camshaft timing gears.
(c) Tighten the chain tensioner No. 3 bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
6. INSTALL NO. 4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing gear
with the knock pin of the No. 4 camshaft, and insert the
No. 4 camshaft into the camshaft timing gear.
(b) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
(c) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(d) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(e) Using several steps, install and tighten the 8 bearing cap
bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(f) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 4 camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(g) Remove the pin from the No. 3. chain tensioner
(h) Release the chain tension between the camshaft timing
gear (RH bank) and crankshaft timing gear by turning
the crankshaft pulley clockwise slightly.
7. INSTALL NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the tensioner as shown
in the illustration.
(b) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(c) Install the chain tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(d) Remove the bar from the chain tensioner.
(e) Install a new gasket and the timing chain cover plate with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
(f) Turn the crankshaft pulley 2 complete revolutions slowly,
and align the notch with the timing mark "0" of the
timing chain cover.
(g) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the bearing
caps as shown in the illustration.
8. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
9. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
10. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
11. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
of the cylinder head, timing chain cover and cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)) to the cylinder head and timing
chain cover as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head cover bolts and nuts must be tightened within 15
minutes. Otherwise the seal packing must be removed
and reapplied.
(c) Install the seal washers to the bolts.
(d) Install the cylinder head cover with the 10 bolts and 2
nuts. Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several
steps.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
12. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head, timing chain cover and cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)) to the cylinder head and timing
chain cover as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, cylinder head
cover bolts and nuts must be tightened within 15
minutes. Otherwise the seal packing must be removed
and reapplied.
(c) Install the seal washers to the bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(d) Install the cylinder head cover with the 10 bolts and 2
nuts. Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several
steps.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
13. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
14. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
(a) Install a new gasket to the intake air surge tank.
(b) Using the socket hexagon wrench 8, install the intake air surge tank with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 28 N·m (286 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
(c) Install the 2 intake air surge tank nuts.
Torque: 28 N·m (286 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the 2 surge tank stays with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(e) Install the oil baffle plate with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
(f) Install the throttle body bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(g) Install the 3 wire harness clamps and hose clamp.
(h) Connect the throttle body with motor connector.
(i) Connect the 2 VSV connectors.
(j) Connect the ventilation hose.
(k) Connect the fuel vapor feed hose.
(l) Connect the 2 water by-pass hoses.
15. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
16. CONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
17. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
18. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
19. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
20. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BR7002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
3. DISCONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
4. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
5. REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
(a) Disconnect the 2 water by-pass hoses.
(b) Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose.
(c) Disconnect the ventilation hose.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(d) Disconnect the 2 VSV connectors.
(e) Disconnect the throttle body with motor connector.
(f) Separate the 3 wire harness clamps and hose clamp.
(g) Remove the 2 bolts and throttle body bracket.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(h) Remove the bolt and oil baffle plate.
(i) Remove the 4 bolts and 2 surge tank stays.
(j) Remove the 2 nuts.
(k) Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the 4 bolts, intake air surge tank and gasket.
6. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
7. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 10 bolts, 3 seal washers, 2 nuts, cylinder
head cover and gasket.
8. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 10 bolts, 3 seal washers, 2 nuts, cylinder
head cover and gasket.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
9. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align the notch with the
timing mark "0" of the timing chain cover.
(b) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the bearing
caps as shown in the illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution (360°)
and align the timing marks as above.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(c) Place paint marks on the No. 1 chain links that
correspond with the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears.
10. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
z
z
Never rotate the crankshaft with the chain tensioner removed.
When rotating the camshaft with the timing chain removed, rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise
40° from the TDC first.
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, timing chain cover plate and
gasket.
(b) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the chain tensioner as
shown in the illustration.
(c) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
11. REMOVE NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) While raising up the No. 2 chain tensioner, insert a pin
of φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 2 camshaft with a
wrench, and remove the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
(c) Separate the camshaft timing gear from the No. 2 camshaft.
(d) Rotate the camshaft counterclockwise using a wrench so
that the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder face upward as
shown in the illustration.
(e) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(f) Remove the 4 bearing caps and No. 2 camshaft.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
12. REMOVE NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the No. 2 chain tensioner bolt, and then remove
the No. 2 chain tensioner and camshaft timing gear.
13. REMOVE CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 1 camshaft with a
wrench, and loosen the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
(b) Slide the camshaft timing gear and separate the No. 1
chain from the camshaft timing gear.
(c) Rotate the No. 1 camshaft counterclockwise using a
wrench so that the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder face
downward as shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(d) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8 bearing
cap bolts in the sequence as shown in the illustration.
(e) Remove the 4 bearing caps.
(f) Remove the camshaft timing gear set bolt with the No. 1
camshaft lifted up, and then remove the No. 1 camshaft
and camshaft timing gear with No. 2 chain.
(g) Tie the No. 1 chain with a string as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing chain
cover.
14. REMOVE NO. 4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) While pushing down the No. 3 chain tensioner, insert a
pin of φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 4 camshaft with a
wrench, and remove the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
(c) Separate the camshaft timing gear from the No. 4 camshaft.
(d) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(e) Remove the 4 bearing caps and No. 4 camshaft.
15. REMOVE NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the No. 3 chain tensioner bolt, and then remove
the No. 3 chain tensioner and camshaft timing gear.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
16. REMOVE NO. 3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Release the chain tension between the camshaft timing
gear (LH bank) and crankshaft timing gear by turning
the crankshaft pulley counterclockwise slightly.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 3 camshaft with a
wrench, and loosen the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
(c) Slide the camshaft timing gear and separate the No. 1
chain from the camshaft timing gear.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CAMSHAFT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(d) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(e) Remove the 4 bearing caps.
(f) Remove the camshaft timing gear set bolt with the No. 3
camshaft lifted up, and then remove the No. 3 camshaft
and camshaft timing gear with No. 2 chain.
(g) Tie the No. 1 chain with a string as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing chain
cover.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BZD002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BZC002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the outside thread
diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
10.85 to 11.00 mm (0.4272 to 0.4331 in.)
Minimum outside diameter:
10.7 mm (0.421 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BZB002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL NO. 2 CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Apply seal packing (diameter: 2.5 to 3 mm (0.098 to
0.118 in.)) to a new cylinder head gasket as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head bolts must be tightened within 15 minutes.
Otherwise the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
(c) Place the cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
surface with the Lot No. stamp upper side facing upward.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful of the installation direction.
Place the cylinder head carefully in order not to damage
the gasket with the bottom part of the head.
2. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD LH
(a) Place the cylinder head on the cylinder head gasket.
(b) Install the 8 cylinder head bolts.
HINT:
z
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive steps (Procedures "A" and "B").
z
If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed, replace it.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
(2) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
(3) Using several steps, tighten each bolt uniformly with
a 10 mm bi-hexagon wrench in the sequence as
shown in the illustration (Procedure "A").
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the cylinder head
bolt.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the washers into the cylinder head.
(4) Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt with
paint.
(5) Retighten the cylinder head bolts 180° as shown (Procedure "B").
(6) Check that the painted marks are now at 180° opposite to the engine front.
(c) Install the 2 cylinder head bolts.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
cylinder head bolts.
(2) Using several steps, install and tighten the 2 cylinder
head bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 30 N·m (306 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the ground cable with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in·lbf)
3. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Apply seal packing (diameter: 2.5 to 3 mm (0.098 to
0.118 in.)) to a new cylinder head gasket as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head bolts must be tightened within 15 minutes.
Otherwise the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
(c) Place the cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
surface with the Lot No. stamp upper side facing upward.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful of the installation direction.
Place the cylinder head carefully in order not to damage
the gasket with the bottom part of the head.
4. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the cylinder head on the cylinder head gasket.
(b) Install the 8 cylinder head bolts.
HINT:
z
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive steps (Procedures "A" and "B").
z
If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed, replace it.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
(2) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
(3) Using several steps, tighten each bolt uniformly with
a 10 mm bi-hexagon wrench in the sequence as
shown in the illustration (Procedure "A").
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the cylinder head
bolt.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Do not drop the washers into the cylinder head.
(4) Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt with
paint.
(5) Retighten the cylinder head bolts 180° as shown (Procedure "B").
(6) Check that the painted marks are now at 180° opposite to the engine front.
(c) Install the ground cables with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in·lbf)
5. INSTALL CAMSHAFTS (for Bank 2)
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Set the crankshaft position.
(1) Install the crankshaft pulley set bolt, and turn the
crankshaft, and set the crankshaft set key at the left
horizontal position.
NOTICE:
Setting the crankshaft at a wrong angle can cause the
piston head and valve head to come into contact with
each other when you install the camshaft, causing
damage. So always set the crankshaft at the correct
angle.
(b) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portions and journals of the camshafts.
(c) Place the 2 camshafts onto the cylinder head with the
cam lobes of No. 2 cylinder facing each correct direction
as shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(d) Install the 8 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f) Using several steps, install and tighten the 16 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
6. INSTALL NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0 mm
(0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Install the No. 3 chain tensioner with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
7. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 2)
(a) Align the mark links (yellow) with the timing marks (1dot mark and 2-dot mark) of the camshaft timing gears
as shown in the illustration.
(b) Align the timing marks on the camshaft timing gears
with the timing marks on the bearing caps, and install
the camshaft timing gears with the chain to the LH
camshafts.
(c) Temporarily install the 2 camshaft timing gear bolts.
NOTICE:
Do not push the camshaft timing gear assembly to the camshaft forcibly when installing it.
(d) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the pin from the No. 3 tensioner.
8. INSTALL NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Install the No. 1 chain vibration damper with the 2 bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
9. INSTALL NO. 2 CAMSHAFT BEARING
(a) Install the No. 2 camshaft bearing to the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Clean the backside of the bearing and the contact
surface of the cylinder head and prevent oil from
adhering to them.
10. INSTALL CAMSHAFTS (for Bank 1)
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Set the crankshaft position.
(1) Using the crankshaft pulley set bolt, turn the
crankshaft, and set the crankshaft set key into the
left horizontal position.
NOTICE:
Having the crankshaft at the wrong angle can cause the
piston head and valve head to come into contact with
each other when you install the camshaft, causing
damage. So always set the crankshaft at the correct
angle.
(b) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portions and journals of the camshafts.
(c) Place the 2 camshafts onto the cylinder head with the
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder facing each direction as shown
in the illustration.
(d) Install the 8 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f) Using several steps, install and tighten the 16 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(g) Turn the camshafts clockwise until the knock pin comes
to 90° position to the cylinder head.
11. INSTALL NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(a) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0 mm
(0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Install the No. 2 chain tensioner with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 1)
(a) Align the mark links (yellow) with the timing marks (1dot mark) of the camshaft timing gears as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Align the timing marks on the camshaft timing gears
with the timing marks on the bearing caps, and install
the camshaft timing gears with the chain to the RH
camshafts.
(c) Temporarily install the 2 camshaft timing gear bolts.
NOTICE:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Do not push the camshaft timing gear assembly to the camshaft forcibly when installing it.
(d) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the pin from the No. 2 tensioner.
13. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
(a) Install a new O-ring to the water outlet pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
(c) Install 2 new gaskets and water by-pass joint RR with the 2 bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
(d) Connect the heater hose.
(e) Connect the engine coolant temperature sensor connector.
14. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Set a new gasket on each cylinder head.
NOTICE:
z
Align the port holes of the gasket and cylinder head.
z
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Set the intake manifold on the cylinder heads.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Install and tighten the 10 bolts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 26 N·m (265 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
(d) Connect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
15. CONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
16. CONNECT NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
17. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Set a new gasket to the LH cylinder head with the oval
shape facing backward.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Install the exhaust manifold with the 6 nuts. Tighten the nuts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 30 N·m (306 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the A/F sensor connector.
18. INSTALL NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY
(a) Install the No. 2 manifold stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
19. INSTALL NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT PIPE ASSEMBLY
20. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Set a new gasket to the RH cylinder head with the oval
shape facing forward.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Install the exhaust manifold with the 6 nuts. Tighten the nuts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 30 N·m (306 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Connect the A/F sensor connector.
21. INSTALL MANIFOLD STAY
(a) Install the manifold stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
22. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
23. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Coat a new O-ring with ATF, and install it to the oil filler tube.
(b) Push in the oil filler tube end into the oil pan lower tube.
(c) Install the oil filler tube with the bolt.
Torque: 12 N·m (122 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the ATF level gauge.
24. INSTALL NO. 1 COOL AIR INLET
(a) Install the cool air inlet with air cleaner hose with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 12 N·m (122 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
25. INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
26. ADD ENGINE OIL
27. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
28. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKAGE
29. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
30. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
31. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
32. INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED
33. INSPECT COMPRESSION
34. INSPECT CO/HC
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BZE002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
4. REMOVE CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
5. REMOVE NO. 1 COOL AIR INLET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and cool air inlet with air cleaner hose.
6. REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the ATF level gauge.
(b) Remove the bolt and pull out the oil filler tube.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the oil filler tube.
7. REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
HINT:
8. REMOVE MANIFOLD STAY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and manifold stay.
9. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
10. REMOVE NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT PIPE ASSEMBLY
11. REMOVE NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and No. 2 manifold stay.
12. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
13. DISCONNECT NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
14. DISCONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
15. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Disconnect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
(b) Remove the 10 bolts, intake manifold and 2 gaskets.
16. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the heater hose.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts, 4 nuts, water by-pass joint RR and
2 gaskets.
(d) Remove the O-ring from the water outlet pipe.
17. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 1)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) While raising the No. 2 chain tensioner, insert a pin of
φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and remove the 2 bolts, camshaft timing gear,
camshaft timing gear assembly and No. 2 timing chain.
NOTICE:
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
z
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
18. REMOVE NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 2 chain tensioner.
19. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS (for Bank 1)
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Rotate the camshafts counterclockwise using a wrench
so that the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder face each
direction as shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 16 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Remove the 8 bearing caps and 2 camshafts.
20. REMOVE NO. 2 CAMSHAFT BEARING
21. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 1 chain vibration damper.
22. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 2)
(a) While pushing down the No. 3 chain tensioner, insert a
pin of φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and remove the 2 bolts, camshaft timing gear,
camshaft timing gear assembly and No. 2 timing chain.
NOTICE:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
z
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
23. REMOVE NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 3 chain tensioner.
24. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS (for Bank 2)
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 16 bearing
cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Remove the 8 bearing caps and 2 camshafts.
25. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the 2 ground cables.
(b) Using several steps, loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts on
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
the cylinder head uniformly with a 10 mm bi-hexagon
wrench in the sequence as shown in the illustration.
Remove the 8 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
z
Be careful not to drop the plate washers into the cylinder
z
head.
Cylinder head warpage or cracking could result from
removing bolts in incorrect order.
(c) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block, and place the cylinder head on wooden blocks on
a bench.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
cylinder head and cylinder block.
HINT:
If the cylinder head is difficult to lift off, pry between the
cylinder head and cylinder block with a screwdriver.
26. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
27. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD LH
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the ground cable.
(b) Using several steps, remove the 2 cylinder head bolts on
the cylinder head in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Using several steps, loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts on
the cylinder head uniformly with a 10 mm bi-hexagon
wrench in the sequence as shown in the illustration.
Remove the 8 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
z
Be careful not to drop the plate washers into the cylinder
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: CYLINDER HEAD: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
head.
Cylinder head warpage or cracking could result from
removing bolts in incorrect order.
z
(d) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block, and place the cylinder head on wooden blocks on
a bench.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
cylinder head and cylinder block.
HINT:
If the cylinder head is difficult to lift off, pry between the
cylinder head and cylinder block with a screwdriver.
28. REMOVE NO. 2 CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002CXS002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017LB003X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the drive belt for excessive wear frayed
cords, etc. If any defect is found, replace the drive belt
HINT:
Cracks on the rib side of a drive belt are considered
acceptable.
HINT:
If the drive belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should
be replaced.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017L9004X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
(a) While turning the belt tensioner counterclockwise, align
with its holes, and then insert a bar of 6 mm (0.24 in.)
into the holes to fix the belt tensioner.
(b) Install the V-ribbed belt.
(c) While turning the belt tensioner counterclockwise, remove the bar.
(d) If it is hard to install the V-ribbed belt, perform the
following procedure.
(1) Put the V-ribbed belt on all parts except the P/S
pump, as shown in the illustration.
(2) While releasing the belt tension by turning the belt
tensioner counterclockwise, put the V-ribbed belt on
the P/S pump.
2. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 1 engine under cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017LA004X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: DRIVE BELT: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, then remove the No. 1 engine under cover sub-assembly.
2. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
(a) While releasing the belt tension by turning the belt
tensioner counterclockwise, remove the V-ribbed belt
from the belt tensioner.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B5K002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B5J002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAUGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
2. INSTALL SPARK PLUG
Torque: 20 N·m (204 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
3. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
4. INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP HOUSING
(a) Install a new gasket and oil filler cap housing with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
5. INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
6. INSTALL WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
7. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the camshaft timing oil control valves to each cylinder head, and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
8. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
9. INSTALL OIL FILTER BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and oil filter bracket with the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
10. INSTALL WATER INLET
11. INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL NO. 1 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
13. INSTALL NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
14. INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET LH
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the engine mounting bracket with engine mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (438 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
15. INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Install the engine mounting bracket with engine mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (438 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
16. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
17. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
18. INSTALL NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
19. INSTALL VENTILATION HOSE
20. INSTALL HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE A (FROM HEATER UNIT)
21. INSTALL HEATER WATER INLET HOSE A
22. INSTALL RADIATOR OUTLET, NO. 2 HOSE CLAMP OR CLIP
23. INSTALL NO. 1 RADIATOR HOSE
24. INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
25. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
26. INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the engine sling device and hang the engine with the chain block.
(b) Lower the engine into the engine room carefully.
(c) Attach the engine mounting brackets to the frame brackets.
(d) Install the engine mounting brackets to the frame brackets with the 4 bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque: 38 N·m (387 kgf·cm, 28 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the 4 bolts and 2 engine hangers.
27. INSTALL NO. 2 ENGINE WIRE
(a) Install the ground cable to the cylinder block.
Torque: 13 N·m (133 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
28. INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the front differential connector.
(b) Insert the engine wire to the cabin space, and install the grommet.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Connect each connector for the ECM, four wheel drive control ECU (4WD only) and instrument
panel wire.
(d) Install the glove compartment door.
(e) Install the cowl side trim board RH.
(f) Install the front door scuff plate RH.
29. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
30. CONNECT HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE A (FROM HEATER UNIT)
31. CONNECT HEATER WATER INLET HOSE B
32. CONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
33. CONNECT NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
34. INSTALL COOLER COMPRESSOR
35. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
36. INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
37. INSTALL FAN PULLEY
38. INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Temporarily install the fan with fluid coupling with the 4 nuts.
39. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
40. FULLY TIGHTEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
41. INSTALL FAN SHROUD
(a) Put the fan shroud into the engine room.
(b) Connect the 2 oil cooler hoses with the hose clamp.
42. INSTALL RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
43. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
44. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
45. CONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
46. INSTALL HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the hood with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 13 N·m (133 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
(b) Tighten the 2 hood supports.
Torque: 18 N·m (184 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the windshield washer hose.
47. ADJUST HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
48. INSTALL BATTERY
49. ADD ENGINE OIL
50. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
51. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
HINT:
52. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
HINT:
53. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
54. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
55. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKAGE
56. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
57. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
58. INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED
59. INSPECT CO/HC
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B5L002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2. REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
HINT:
3. REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
HINT:
4. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
5. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
6. REMOVE BATTERY
7. REMOVE HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the windshield washer hose.
(b) Separate the 2 hood supports.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and hood.
8. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
9. REMOVE NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
10. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
11. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support seal upper.
12. REMOVE RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
13. REMOVE FAN SHROUD
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Unfasten the hose clamp, and disconnect the 2 oil cooler hoses from the fan shroud.
(b) Remove the fan shroud.
14. LOOSEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
15. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
16. REMOVE FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and fan with fluid coupling.
17. REMOVE FAN PULLEY
18. SEPARATE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
19. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
20. SEPARATE COOLER COMPRESSOR
21. DISCONNECT NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
22. DISCONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
23. DISCONNECT HEATER WATER INLET HOSE B
24. DISCONNECT HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE A (FROM HEATER UNIT)
25. REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
26. SEPARATE ENGINE WIRE
(a) Remove the front door scuff plate RH
.
(b) Remove the cowl side trim board RH
.
(c) Remove the glove compartment door
.
(d) Disconnect each connector for the ECM, four wheel drive control ECU (4WD only) and instrument
panel wire before pulling out the engine wire into the engine room.
(e) Disconnect the front differential connector.
27. SEPARATE NO. 2 ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the ground cable from the cylinder block.
28. REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 engine hangers with the 4 bolts as shown in
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
the illustration.
Part No.:
Engine hanger No. 1: 12281-31070
Engine hanger No. 2: 12282-31050
Bolt: 91671-10825
Torque: 33 N·m (336 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
(b) Attach the engine sling device and hang the engine with the chain block.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and 4 nuts, and separate the engine
mounting brackets from the frame brackets.
(d) Lift the engine out of the vehicle carefully.
NOTICE:
Make sure the engine is clear of all wiring and hoses.
(e) Place the engine onto a working bench.
29. REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
30. REMOVE ENGINE WIRE
31. REMOVE NO. 1 RADIATOR HOSE
32. REMOVE RADIATOR OUTLET, NO. 2 HOSE CLAMP OR CLIP
33. REMOVE HEATER WATER INLET HOSE A
34. REMOVE HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE A (FROM HEATER UNIT)
35. REMOVE VENTILATION HOSE
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
36. REMOVE NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
37. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
38. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
39. INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD FOR FLATNESS
(a) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge,
measure the warpage of the contact surface of the
cylinder head.
Maximum warpage:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the
exhaust manifold.
HINT:
Maximum warpage of each installation surface:
HINT:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
40. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine mounting bracket with engine mounting insulator.
41. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET LH
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and engine mounting bracket with engine mounting insulator.
42. REMOVE NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 idler pulleys.
43. REMOVE NO. 1 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
44. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
45. REMOVE WATER INLET
46. REMOVE OIL FILTER BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts, oil filter bracket and gasket.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE ASSEMBLY: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
47. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
48. INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD FOR FLATNESS
(a) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge,
measure the warpage of the contact surface of the
cylinder head and intake air surge tank.
Maximum warpage:
Intake air surge tank side
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
Cylinder head side
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the
intake manifold.
49. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 camshaft timing oil control valves.
50. REMOVE WATER BY-PASS JOINT RR
51. REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
52. REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP HOUSING
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, oil filler cap housing and gasket.
53. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
54. REMOVE SPARK PLUG
55. REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAUGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
56. REMOVE PARTIAL ENGINE ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4L002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4K002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the timing chain cover
edge.
SST: 09226-10010
2. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
HINT:
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
3. INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
4. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
5. FULLY TIGHTEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
6. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
7. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
(a) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal.
Torque: 3.9 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
8. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKAGE
9. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the engine under cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
10. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4M002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
2. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
3. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support seal upper.
4. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE UNDER COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine under cover.
5. LOOSEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
6. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
7. REMOVE FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
8. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
HINT:
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
SST: 09950-50013
09951-05010
09952-05010
09953-05020
09954-05030
9. REMOVE TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE FRONT OIL SEAL: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Wrap the tip
of the screwdriver with tape.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4W002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4V002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer
edge.
SST: 09223-78010
2. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the mounting bolt
end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or
Equivalent
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Install the front spacer, drive plate and rear spacer on
the crankshaft.
(d) Using several steps, install and tighten the 8 mounting bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 83 N·m (846 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
3. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
HINT:
4. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
HINT:
5. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKAGE
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4X002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
HINT:
2. REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
HINT:
3. REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
(b) Remove the 8 bolts, front spacer, drive plate and rear
spacer.
4. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BK4002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BK5002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
z
z
z
Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
Replace all gaskets, O-rings and oil seals with new ones.
1. REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE HANGER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 1 engine hanger.
2. REMOVE NO. 2 ENGINE HANGER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 engine hanger.
3. REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Remove the bolt and pull out the oil level gauge guide.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the oil level gauge guide.
4. REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 water drain cocks.
5. REMOVE VVT SENSOR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 VVT sensors.
6. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and crankshaft position sensor.
7. REMOVE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the plug, filter and gasket from each cylinder
head.
8. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 10 bolts, 3 seal washers, 2 nuts, cylinder
head cover and gasket.
9. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 10 bolts, 3 seal washers, 2 nuts, cylinder
head cover and gasket.
(b) Remove the ventilation valve from the cylinder head cover.
10. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align the notch with the
timing mark "0" of the timing chain cover.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the bearing
caps as shown in the illustration.
(c) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and loosen the
pulley set bolt.
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
(d) Using the pulley set bolt and SST, remove the
crankshaft pulley.
SST: 09950-50013
09951-05010
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
09952-05010
09953-05020
09954-05030
11. REMOVE OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
(a) Remove the drain plug and gasket.
12. REMOVE NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Insert the blade of SST between the oil pan and No. 2 oil
pan, and cut off applied sealer and remove the No. 2 oil
pan.
SST: 09032-00100
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the oil
pan and No. 2 oil pan.
Be careful not to damage the No. 2 oil pan flange.
13. REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
14. REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 17 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Remove the 4 stud bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying
between the oil pan and cylinder block as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
cylinder block and oil pan.
(d) Remove the O-ring from the oil pump.
15. REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the 17 bolts, water pump and gasket.
16. REMOVE TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 15 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Remove the timing chain cover by prying between the
timing chain cover and cylinder head or cylinder block
with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
timing chain cover, cylinder block and cylinder head.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the LH cylinder head.
17. REMOVE TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil pump assembly. Wrap
the tip of the screwdriver with tape.
18. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
z
z
Never rotate the crankshaft with the chain tensioner removed.
When rotating the camshaft with the timing chain removed, rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise
40° from the TDC first.
(a) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the chain tensioner as
shown in the illustration.
(b) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
19. REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
20. REMOVE NO. 1 IDLE GEAR SHAFT
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the No. 2 idle
gear shaft, No. 1 idle gear and No. 1 idle gear shaft.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
21. REMOVE NO. 2 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Remove the 2 No. 2 chain vibration dampers.
22. REMOVE CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
23. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
24. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 1 chain vibration damper.
25. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 1)
(a) While raising the No. 2 chain tensioner, insert a pin of
φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and remove the 2 bolts, camshaft timing gear,
camshaft timing gear assembly and No. 2 timing chain.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
26. REMOVE NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 2 chain tensioner.
27. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 2)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) While pushing down the No. 3 chain tensioner, insert a
pin of φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and remove the 2 bolts, camshaft timing gear,
camshaft timing gear assembly and No. 2 timing chain.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
28. REMOVE NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 3 chain tensioner.
29. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Remove the camshafts of the RH bank.
(1) Rotate the camshafts counterclockwise using a
wrench so that the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder face
each direction as shown in the illustration.
(2) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 16
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in
the illustration.
(3) Remove the 8 bearing caps and 2 camshafts.
(b) Remove the camshafts of the LH bank.
(1) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 16
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration.
(2) Remove the 8 bearing caps and 2 camshafts.
30. REMOVE NO. 1 CAMSHAFT BEARING
31. REMOVE NO. 2 CAMSHAFT BEARING
32. REMOVE CYLINDER HEADS
(a) Using several steps, remove the 2 cylinder head bolts on
the LH cylinder head in the sequence as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Using several steps, loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts on
each cylinder head with a 10 mm bi-hexagon wrench in
the sequence as shown in the illustration. Remove the
16 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the plate washers into the cylinder
head.
Cylinder head warpage or cracking could result from
removing bolts in incorrect order.
z
z
(c) Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block, and place the 2 cylinder heads on wooden blocks
on a bench.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
cylinder head and cylinder block.
HINT:
If the cylinder head is difficult to lift off, pry between the
cylinder head and cylinder block with a screwdriver.
(d) Remove the RH and LH cylinder head gaskets.
33. REMOVE NO. 1 WATER OUTLET PIPE
(a) Separate the knock sensor wire.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and water outlet pipe.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
34. REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the knock sensor connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 knock sensors.
35. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal retainer by prying between the oil seal retainer and
crankshaft bearing cap.
36. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil seal.
37. REMOVE VALVE LIFTER
HINT:
Arrange the valve lifter in the correct order.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
38. REMOVE VALVE
HINT:
Arrange the valves, inner compression springs, valve spring retainers and valve spring retainer locks
in the correct order.
(a) Place the cylinder head on a wooden block.
(b) Using SST, compress the inner compression spring and remove the 2 valve spring retainer locks.
SST: 09202-70020
09202-00010
(c) Remove the valve, inner compression spring, valve spring and valve spring retainer.
39. REMOVE VALVE SPRING SEAT
(a) Using compressed air and a magnetic finger, remove the
valve spring seat by blowing air.
40. REMOVE VALVE STEM OIL O SEAL OR RING
(a) Using needle-nose pliers, remove the valve stem oil
seal.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
41. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.15 to 0.30 mm (0.0059 to 0.0118 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
42. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Check the matchmarks on the connecting rod and cap are aligned to ensure correct reassembling.
(b) Remove the 2 connecting rod cap bolts.
(c) Clean the crank pin, bearing and connecting rod.
(d) Check the crank pin and bearing for pits and scratches.
(e) Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
(f) Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is
facing the correct direction.
(g) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
(h) Tighten the bolts alternately with the specified torque.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(i) Mark the front side of each connecting cap bolt with
paint.
(j) Retighten the cap bolts 90° as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(k) Remove the 2 bolts, connecting rod cap and lower bearing.
(l) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.026 to 0.046 mm (0.0010 to 0.0018 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.066 mm (0.0025 in.)
NOTICE:
Completely remove the Plastigage.
(m) If replacing a bearing, replace it with one that has the
same number marked on the connecting rod. There are 4
sizes of standard bearings, marked "1 ", "2", "3" and "4"
accordingly.
HINT:
Standard bearing center wall thickness
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
MARK
MM (IN.)
"1"
1.484 to 1.487 (0.0584 to 0.0585)
"2"
1.487 to 1.490 (0.0585 to 0.0587)
"3"
1.490 to 1.493 (0.0587 to 0.0588)
"4"
1.493 to 1.496 (0.0588 to 0.0589)
43. REMOVE PISTON SUB-ASSEMBLY WITH CONNECTING ROD
(a) Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the top
of the cylinder.
(b) Push in the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper bearing through the top of the cylinder
block.
HINT:
z
z
Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap together.
Arrange the piston and connecting rod assemblies in the correct order.
44. REMOVE CONNECTING ROD BEARING
45. REMOVE PISTON RING SET
(a) Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compression
rings.
(b) Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring by hand.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
46. REMOVE PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
47. REMOVE WITH PIN PISTON SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Gradually heat the piston to approx. 80°C (176°F).
(b) Using a plastic-faced hammer and brass bar, lightly tap
out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
HINT:
z
z
The piston and pin are a matched set.
Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods and
bearings in the correct order.
48. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
prying the crankshaft back and forth with a screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.04 to 0.24 mm (0.0016 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the pair of the thrust washers or a crankshaft.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
HINT:
Thrust washer thickness is 1.93 to 1.98 mm (0.0760 to 0.0780
in.)
49. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
(a) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8 main
bearing cap bolts and seal washers uniformly in the
sequence as shown in the illustration.
(b) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 16 main
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Using a screwdriver, pry out the main bearing caps.
Remove the 4 main bearing caps and lower bearings.
NOTICE:
z
z
Pull up the main bearing cap while turning it little by little
to the right and the left.
Be careful not to damage the joint surfaces of the
cylinder block and the main bearing cap.
50. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER SET
51. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT BEARING
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
52. REMOVE NO. 1 OIL NOZZLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a 5 mm socket hexagon wrench, remove the 3 oil
nozzles.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BK3002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CAMSHAFTS
(a) Inspect the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout at the
center journal.
Maximum runout:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace
the camshaft.
(b) Inspect the cam lobes.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Intake
44.168 to 44.268 mm (1.7389 to 1.7428 in.)
Exhaust
44.580 to 44.680 mm (1.7551 to 1.7591 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
Intake
44.018 mm (1.7330 in.)
Exhaust
44.430 mm (1.7492 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum,
replace the camshaft.
(c) Inspect the camshaft journals.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
No. 1 journal diameter:
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Other journal diameter:
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the
oil clearance.
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Fix the intake camshaft with a vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(b) Align the knock pin hole in the camshaft timing gear
assembly with the knock pin of the camshaft, and install
the camshaft timing gear assembly with the bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(c) Confirm the camshaft timing gear assembly is locked.
(d) Release the lock pin.
(1) Cover 4 oil paths of the cam journal with a masking
tape as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
One of the 2 grooves on the cam journal is for retards (upper)
and the other is for advances (lower). Each groove has 2 oil
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
paths. Plug one of the oil paths for each groove with rubber
pieces before wrapping the cam journal with tape.
(2) Prick a hole in the tape placed on the advance side
path. Prick a hole in the retard side path, on the
opposite side to that of the advance side path, as
shown in the illustration.
(3) Apply about 200 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm 2) of air pressure
to the two broken paths (the advance side path and
the retard side path).
NOTICE:
Cover the paths with a shop rag to avoid oil splashing.
(4) Confirm that the camshaft timing gear assembly
rotates in the advance direction when reducing the
air pressure applied to the retard path.
HINT:
When the lock pin is released, the camshaft timing gear
rotates in the advance direction.
(5) When the camshaft timing gear comes to the most
advanced position, release the air pressure from the
retard side path, and then release the air pressure
from the advance side path.
NOTICE:
The camshaft timing assembly gear occasionally shifts
to the retard side abruptly, if air compression of the
advanced side path is released first. It often results in
the breakage of the lock pin.
(e) Check for smooth revolution.
(1) Except the position where the lock pin meets at the most retard angle, turn the camshaft
timing gear assembly back and forth and check the movable range and that there is no
disturbance.
Standard:
Movable smoothly in the range about 31°
NOTICE:
Be sure to perform this check by hand, instead of air pressure.
(f) Check the lock in the most retarded position.
(1) Confirm that the camshaft timing gear assembly is locked at the most retarded position.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(g) Remove the set bolt and camshaft timing gear
assembly.
NOTICE:
Be sure not to remove the other 3 bolts.
3. INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the outside thread
diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
10.85 to 11.00 mm (0.4272 to 0.4331 in.)
Minimum outside diameter:
10.7 mm (0.421 in.)
4. INSPECT CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a spring scale, pull the chain sub assembly with a
force of 147 N (15.0 kgf, 33.1 lbf) and measure the
length of the chain sub assembly by vernier calipers.
Maximum chain elongation:
146.8 mm (5.780 in.)
NOTICE:
Perform the same measurements by pulling at random
in 3 or more places to obtain an average length.
If the elongation is greater than the maximum, replace
the chain.
5. INSPECT NO. 2 CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a spring scale, pull the chain sub assembly with a
force of 147 N (15.0 kgf, 33.1 lbf) and measure the
length of the chain sub assembly by vernier calipers.
Maximum chain elongation:
146.8 mm (5.780 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Perform the same measurements by pulling at random
in 3 or more places to obtain an average length.
If the elongation is greater than the maximum, replace
the chain.
6. INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Put the No. 1 chain on the larger gear of the camshaft
timing gear assembly.
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the timing gear with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (with chain):
115.5 mm (4.547 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier calipers must contact the chain rollers for the measuring.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the No. 1 chain and camshaft timing gear
assembly.
(c) Put the No. 2 chain on the smaller gear of the camshaft
timing gear assembly.
(d) Using vernier calipers, measure the timing gear with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (with chain):
73.1 mm (2.878 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
The vernier calipers must contact the chain rollers for the measuring.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the No. 2 chain and camshaft timing gear
assembly.
7. INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
(a) Put the No. 2 chain on the camshaft timing gear.
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the camshaft timing gear diameter with the chain .
Minimum gear diameter (with chain):
73.1 mm (2.878 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier calipers must contact the chain rollers for the measuring.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the No. 2 chain and the camshaft timing gear.
8. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
(a) Put the No. 1 chain on the crankshaft timing gear.
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the crankshaft timing gear diameter with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (with chain):
61.0 mm (2.402 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier calipers must contact the chain rollers for the measuring.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the No. 1 chain and crankshaft timing gear.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
9. INSPECT NO. 1 IDLE GEAR
(a) Put the No. 1 chain on the idle gear.
(b) Using vernier calipers, measure the idle gear with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (with chain):
61.0 mm (2.402 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier calipers must contact the chain rollers for the measuring.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the No. 1 chain and idle gear.
10. INSPECT IDLE GEAR SHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the idle gear shaft
diameter.
Idle gear shaft diameter:
22.987 to 23.000 mm (0.9050 to 0.9055 in.)
(b) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the idle gear.
Idle gear inside diameter:
23.02 to 23.03 mm (0.9063 to 0.9067 in.)
(c) Subtract the idle gear shaft diameter measurement from the idle gear inside diameter
measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
0.020 to 0.043 mm (0.0008 to 0.0017 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.093 mm (0.0037 in.)
11. INSPECT NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the plunger moves smoothly when the
ratchet pawl is raised with your finger.
(b) Release the ratchet pawl and check that the plunger is locked in place by the ratchet pawl and
does not move when pushing with your finger.
12. INSPECT NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the plunger moves smoothly.
(b) Measure the worn depth of the chain tensioner slipper.
Maximum depth:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the No. 2 chain tensioner.
13. INSPECT NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the plunger moves smoothly.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Measure the worn depth of the chain tensioner slipper.
Maximum depth:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the No. 3 chain tensioner.
14. INSPECT CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
(a) Measure the worn depth of the chain tensioner slipper.
Maximum depth:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the
chain tensioner slipper.
15. INSPECT NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Measure the worn depth of the No. 1 chain vibration
damper.
Maximum depth:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the
No. 1 chain vibration damper.
16. INSPECT NO. 2 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Measure the worn depth of the No. 2 chain vibration
damper.
Maximum depth:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the
No. 2 chain vibration damper.
17. CLEAN CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block contact surface.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block contact
surface.
(b) Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from the
combustion chambers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the combustion chambers.
(c) Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent, clean all
the valve guide bushes.
(d) Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the
cylinder head.
18. INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Inspect warpage.
(1) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge,
measure the warpage of the contact surfaces of the
cylinder block and manifolds.
Maximum warpage:
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the
cylinder head.
(b) Inspect cranks.
(1) Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion
chamber, intake ports, exhaust ports and cylinder
block surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
19. CLEAN VALVE
(a) Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon from the
valve head.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using a wire brush, thoroughly clean the valve.
20. INSPECT VALVE
(a) Inspect the valve stem diameter.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
valve stem.
Valve stem diameter:
INTAKE
EXHAUST
5.470 to 5.485 mm
5.465 to 5.480 mm
(0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
(0.2152 to 0.2158 in.)
(b) Inspect the valve face angle.
(1) Grind the valve enough to remove pits and carbon.
(2) Check that the valve is ground to the correct valve
face angle.
Valve face angle:
44.5°
(c) Inspect the valve head margin thickness.
(1) Using vernier calipers, check the valve head margin
thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum margin thickness:
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
(d) Inspect the overall length.
(1) Using vernier calipers, check the overall length.
Standard overall length:
INTAKE
EXHAUST
106.95 mm (4.2106 in.)
105.80 mm (4.1654 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Minimum overall length:
INTAKE
EXHAUST
106.40 mm (4.1890 in.)
105.30 mm (4.1457 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum, replace the valve.
(e) Inspect the valve stem tip.
(1) Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
NOTICE:
Do not grind off more than the minimum length.
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a
grinder or replace the valve.
21. CLEAN VALVE SEAT
(a) Using a 45° carbide cutter, resurface the valve seats.
(b) Clean the valve seats.
22. INSPECT VALVE SEAT
(a) Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to the
valve face.
(b) Lightly press the valve against the valve seat.
NOTICE:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Do not rotate the valve.
(c) Check the valve face and seat according to the following procedure.
(1) If prussian blue appears around the entire face, the valve is centered.
If not, replace the valve.
(2) If prussian blue appears around the entire valve seat, the guide and face are centered.
If not, resurface the valve seat.
(3) Check that the seat contacts the middle of the valve face with the width below.
Standard width:
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
23. REPAIR VALVE SEAT
NOTICE:
Take off a cutter gradually to make the intake valve seat smooth.
(a) If the seating is too high to the valve face, use 30° and
45° cutters to correct the seat.
(b) Intake side:
If the seating is too low to the valve face, use 60° and
45° cutters to correct the seat.
(c) Exhaust side:
If the seating is too low to the valve face, use 75° and
45° cutters to correct the seat.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(d) Handrub the valve and valve seat with an abrasive
compound.
(e) After handrubbing, clean the valve and valve seat.
24. INSPECT INNER COMPRESSION SPRING
(a) Inspect squareness.
(1) Using a steel square, measure the squareness of the
inner compression spring.
Maximum deviation:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than the maximum, replace
the inner compression spring.
(b) Inspect free length.
(1) Using vernier calipers, measure the free length of the
inner compression spring.
Free length:
47.80 mm (1.8819 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the inner
compression spring.
(c) Inspect tension.
(1) Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the
inner compression spring at the specified installed
length.
Installed tension:
186.2 to 205.8 N (19.0 to 21.0 kgf, 41.9 to 46.3 lbf) at
33.3 mm (1.311 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
inner compression spring.
25. INSPECT VALVE GUIDE BUSH OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the valve guide bush.
Inside diameter:
5.51 to 5.53 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
(b) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement (Step 8) from the valve guide bush inside diameter
measurement.
Standard overall length:
INTAKE
EXHAUST
0.025 to 0.060 mm
0.030 to 0.065 mm
(0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
(0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Minimum overall length:
INTAKE
EXHAUST
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the valve and valve guide bush.
26. REMOVE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C (176 to
212°F).
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Place the cylinder head on a wooden block.
(c) Using SST, tap out the valve guide bush.
SST: 09201-10000
SST: 09201-01055
SST: 09950-70010
09951-07100
27. INSTALL VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Bush bore diameter:
10.295 to 10.315 mm (0.4053 to 0.4061 in.)
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater
than 10.315 mm (0.4061 in.), machine the bush bore to
the dimension of 10.345 to 10.365 mm (0.4073 to
0.4081 in.).
Valve guide bush diameter
STD
10.333 to 10.344 mm (0.4068 to 0.4072 in.)
O/S 0.05
10.383 to 10.394 mm (0.4088 to 0.4092 in.)
(b) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C (176 to
212°F).
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Place the cylinder head on a wooden block.
(d) Using SST, tap in a new valve guide bush to the specified protrusion height.
SST: 09201-10000
SST: 09201-01055
SST: 09950-70010
09951-07100
Protrusion height:
9.3 to 9.7 mm (0.366 to 0.382 in.)
(e) Using a sharp 5.5 mm reamer, ream the valve guide
bush to obtain the standard specified clearance between
the valve guide bush and valve stem.
Standard overall length:
INTAKE
EXHAUST
0.025 to 0.060 mm
0.030 to 0.065 mm
(0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
(0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
28. INSPECT VALVE LIFTER
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the valve lifter diameter.
Valve lifter diameter:
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
29. INSPECT VALVE LIFTER OIL CLEARANCE
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
(b) Subtract the valve lifter diameter measurement (Step 16) from the lifter bore diameter
measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the valve lifter.
If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
30. INSPECT CAMSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Clean the camshaft bearing caps, camshaft bearings and
camshaft journals.
(b) Install the camshaft bearing
.
(c) Place the camshaft on the cylinder head.
(d) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft journals.
(e) Install the camshaft bearing caps
.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshafts.
(f) Remove the camshaft bearing caps
.
(g) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance (Cylinder head RH):
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
NO. 1 (INTAKE)
NO. 1 (EXHAUST)
OTHERS
0.008 to 0.038 mm
0.040 to 0.079 mm 0.025 to 0.062 mm
(0.0003 to 0.0015
in.)
(0.0016 to 0.0031
in.)
(0.0010 to 0.0024
in.)
Standard oil clearance (Cylinder head LH):
NO. 1
OTHERS
0.040 to 0.079 mm
0.025 to 0.062 mm
(0.0016 to 0.0031 in.)
(0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum oil clearance (Cylinder head RH):
NO. 1 (INTAKE)
OTHERS
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Maximum oil clearance (Cylinder head LH):
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the camshaft bearings and/or camshaft.
If necessary, replace the camshaft bearing caps and cylinder head together.
Reference:
Cylinder head journal bore diameter
Camshaft bearing center wall thickness (Mark "2")
Camshaft journal diameter
(h) Remove the Plastigage completely.
(i) Remove the camshafts.
(j) Remove the camshaft bearing.
31. INSPECT CAMSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
40.009 to 40.017 mm
(1.5752 to 1.5755 in.)
2.004 to 2.008 mm
(0.0789 to 0.0791 in.)
35.971 to 35.985 mm
(1.4165 to 1.4167 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the camshafts
.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.04 to 0.09 mm (0.0016 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the camshafts.
If necessary, replace the camshaft bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
32. INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK FOR FLATNESS
(a) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge,
measure the warpage of the contact surface of the
cylinder head gasket.
Maximum warpage:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the
cylinder block.
33. INSPECT CYLINDER BORE
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore
diameter at positions A and B in the thrust and axial
directions.
Standard diameter:
94.000 to 94.012 mm (3.7008 to 3.7013 in.)
Maximum diameter:
94.132 mm (3.7060 in.)
If the average diameter of 4 positions is greater than the
maximum, replace the cylinder block.
34. INSPECT WITH PIN PISTON SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
right angles to the piston pin center line, 27.7 mm (1.091
in.) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
93.910 to 93.920 mm (3.6972 to 3.6976 in.)
35. INSPECT PISTON OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.080 to 0.102 mm (0.0031 to 0.0040 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace all the 6 pistons. If necessary, replace the
cylinder block.
36. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the
connecting rod alignment.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(1) Check for misalignment.
Maximum misalignment:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If misalignment is greater than the maximum, replace
the connecting rod assembly.
(2) Check twist.
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If twist is greater than the maximum, replace the
connecting rod assembly.
37. INSPECT PISTON PIN OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the piston pin hole.
Piston pin hole inside diameter:
22.001 to 22.010 mm (0.8662 to 0.8665 in.)
HINT:
Piston pin hole inside diameter
MARK
MM (IN.)
A
22.001 to 22.004 (0.8662 to 0.8663)
B
22.005 to 22.007 (0.8663 to 0.8664)
C
22.008 to 22.010 (0.8665 to 0.8665)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
HINT:
Piston pin diameter
MARK
MM (IN.)
A
21.997 to 22.000 (0.8660 to 0.8661)
B
22.001 to 22.003 (0.8661 to 0.8663)
C
22.004 to 22.006 (0.8663 to 0.8664)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of
the connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
HINT:
Bushing inside diameter
MARK
MM (IN.)
A
22.005 to 22.008 (0.8663 to 0.8665)
B
22.009 to 22.011 (0.8665 to 0.8666)
C
22.012 to 22.014 (0.8666 to 0.8667)
(d) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the piston pin hole diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.001 to 0.007 mm (0.00004 to 0.00028 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.040 mm (0.0016 in.)
(e) If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace
the bushing. If necessary, replace the piston and piston
pin together.
(f) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.050 mm (0.0020 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(g) If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the bushing. If necessary, replace the
connecting rod and piston pin together.
38. REMOVE CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the bushing.
SST: 09222-30010
39. INSTALL CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
(a) Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the connecting
rod.
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the bushing.
SST: 09222-30010
(c) Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain the
standard specified clearance between the bushing and
piston pin.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
HINT:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Check that the piston pin fits at a normal room temperature.
Coat the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into the
connecting rod with a thumb.
40. INSPECT RING GROOVE CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the
new piston ring and the wall of the ring groove.
Ring groove clearance:
No. 1
0.02 to 0.07 mm (0.0008 to 0.0028 in.)
No. 2
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
Oil
0.07 to 0.15 mm (0.0028 to 0.0060 in.)
41. INSPECT PISTON RING END GAP
(a) Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond the
bottom of the ring travel, 110mm (4.33 in.) from the top
of the cylinder block.
(b) Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap:
No. 1
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.0118 to 0.0157 in.)
No. 2
0.40 to 0.50 mm (0.0157 to 0.0197 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.10 to 0.40 mm (0.0039 to 0.0157 in.)
Maximum end gap:
No. 1
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
No. 2
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
42. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the tension portion
diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.2 to 7.3 mm (0.283 to 0.287 in.)
Minimum diameter:
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
bolt.
43. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT BEARING CAP SET BOLT
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the tension portion
diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter:
10.0 to 10.2 mm (0.393 to 0.402 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
bolt.
44. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT
(a) Using a dial indicator and V-blocks, measure the runout
as shown in the illustration.
Maximum circle runout:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each main
journal.
Diameter:
71.988 to 72.000 mm (2.8342 to 2.8346 in.)
(c) Check each main journal for taper and out-of-round as shown.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
(d) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each crank
pin.
Diameter:
55.992 to 56.000 mm (2.2044 to 2.2047 in.)
(e) Check each crank pin for taper and out-of-round as shown.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
45. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
HINT:
Main bearings come in widths of 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) and 22.4 mm (0.882 in.). Install the 22.4 mm
(0.882 in.) bearings in the No. 1 and No. 4 cylinder block journal positions with the main bearing cap.
Install the 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) bearings in the No. 2 and No. 3 positions.
(a) Clean each main journal and bearing.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
cylinder block, and push in the 4 upper bearings.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the bearing or its contact
surface.
(c) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the main
bearing cap, and push in the 4 bottom bearings.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the bearing or its contact
surface.
HINT:
A number marked on each main bearing cap indicates the
installation position.
(d) Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(e) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
(f) Examine the front marks and numbers and install the
bearing caps on the cylinder block.
(g) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(h) Temporarily install the 8 main bearing cap bolts to the inside positions.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(i) Install the main bearing caps. Tighten the 2 bolts for each
bearing cap until the clearance between the bearing cap
and the cylinder block becomes less than 6 mm (0.23
in.).
(j) Using a plastic-faced hammer, lightly tap the bearing cap
to ensure a proper fit.
(k) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the main bearing cap bolts.
(l) Install the 16 main bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 61 N·m (622 kgf·cm, 45 ft·lbf)
(m) Mark the front side of the bearing cap bolts with paint.
(n) Retighten the bearing cap bolts 90° in the sequence as shown.
(o) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the front.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(p) Install the 8 main bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 26 N·m (262 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
(q) Remove the main bearing caps.
(r) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.018 to 0.030 mm (0.0007 to 0.0012 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.046 mm (0.0018 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace
the bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
NOTICE:
Completely remove the Plastigage.
(s) If replacing a bearing, replace it with one that has the
same number. If the number of the bearing cannot be
determined, select the correct bearing by adding together
the numbers imprinted on the cylinder block and
crankshaft, then refer to the table below for appropriate
bearing number. There are 5 sizes of standard bearings,
marked "1", "2", "3", "4" and "5" accordingly.
Journal bearings
HINT:
CYLINDER BLOCK (A) + CRANKSHAFT
USE BEARING
0-5
"1"
6 - 11
"2"
12 - 17
"3"
18 - 23
"4"
24 - 28
"5"
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
EXAMPLE
HINT:
Cylinder block "11" (A) + Crankshaft "06" (B) = Total number 17 (Use bearing "3")
ITEM
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter (A)
Crankshaft main journal diameter (B)
MARK
MM (IN.)
"00"
77.000 (3.0315)
"01"
77.001 (3.0315)
"02"
77.002 (3.0316)
"03"
77.003 (3.0316)
"04"
77.004 (3.0317)
"05"
77.005 (3.0317)
"06"
77.006 (3.0317)
"07"
77.007 (3.0318)
"08"
77.008 (3.0318)
"09"
77.009 (3.0319)
"10"
77.010 (3.0319)
"11"
77.011 (3.0319)
"12"
77.012 (3.0320)
"13"
77.013 (3.0320)
"14"
77.014 (3.0320)
"15"
77.015 (3.0321)
"16"
77.016 (3.0321)
"00"
71.999 to 72.000 (2.8346 to 2.8346)
"01"
71.998 to 71.999 (2.8346 to 2.8346)
"02"
71.997 to 71.998 (2.8345 to 2.8346)
"03"
71.996 to 71.997 (2.8345 to 2.8346)
"04"
71.995 to 71.996 (2.8344 to 2.8345)
"05"
71.994 to 71.995 (2.8344 to 2.8344)
"06"
71.993 to 71.994 (2.8343 to 2.8344)
"07"
71.992 to 71.993 (2.8343 to 2.8343)
"08"
71.991 to 71.992 (2.8343 to 2.8343)
"09"
71.990 to 71.991 (2.8343 to 2.8343)
"10"
71.989 to 71.990 (2.8342 to 2.8343)
"11"
71.988 to 71.989 (2.8342 to 2.8342)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Standard bearing center wall thickness
"1"
2.488 to 2.491 (0.0980 to 0.0981)
"2"
2.491 to 2.494 (0.0981 to 0.0982)
"3"
2.494 to 2.497 (0.0982 to 0.0983)
"4"
2.497 to 2.500 (0.0982 to 0.0984)
"5"
2.500 to 2.503 (0.0984 to 0.0985)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002BK6002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
REASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Install the stud bolts as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 11 N·m (112 kgf·cm, 8.1 ft·lbf)
Torque: 4.5 N·m (46 kgf·cm, 40 in·lbf)
Torque: 4.0 N·m (41 kgf·cm, 35 in·lbf)
2. INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in the straight pin.
Standard protrusion:
22.5 to 23.5 mm (0.886 to 0.925 in.) for pin A
10.5 to 11.5 mm (0.413 to 0.453 in.) for pin B
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.) for pin C
5.5 to 6.5 mm (0.217 to 0.256 in.) for pin D
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
3. INSTALL TIGHT PLUG
(a) Apply adhesive around the tight plugs.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
(b) Using SST, install the tight plugs as shown in the illustration.
SST: 09950-60010
09951-00350
SST: 09950-70010
09951-07150
Standard depth:
0.2 to 1.2 mm (0.008 to 0.047 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
4. INSTALL OIL JET
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the oil jet.
5. INSTALL NO. 1 OIL NOZZLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a 5 mm socket hexagon wrench, install the 3 oil
nozzles.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
6. INSTALL PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, install a new snap ring on one side
of the piston pin hole.
HINT:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Check that an end gap of the snap ring is not overlapped to
the pin hole cutout portion of the piston.
7. INSTALL WITH PIN PISTON SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Gradually heat the piston to about 80°C (176°F).
(b) Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
(c) Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod, and push in the piston pin with a thumb.
8. INSTALL PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the other
side of the piston pin hole.
HINT:
Be sure that an end gap of the snap ring is not overlapped to
the pin hole cutout portion of the piston.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
9. INSTALL PISTON RING SET
(a) Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
(b) Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compression rings.
NOTICE:
Install the No. 2 compression ring with the painted mark facing upward.
(c) Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown.
10. INSTALL CONNECTING ROD BEARING
(a) Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connecting
rod or connecting cap.
NOTICE:
Clean the backside of the bearing and the contact
surface of the connecting rod and prevent oil from
adhering to them.
11. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT BEARING
HINT:
Main bearings come in widths of 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) and 22.4 mm (0.882 in.). Install the 22.4 mm
(0.882 in.) bearings in the No. 1 and No. 4 cylinder block journal positions with the main bearing cap.
Install the 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) bearings in the No. 2 and No. 3 positions.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(b) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
cylinder block, and push in the 4 upper bearings.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the bearing and its contact
surface.
(c) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the main
bearing cap, and push in the 4 lower bearings.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the bearing and its contact
surface.
HINT:
The number marked on each main bearing cap indicates the
installation position.
12. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT
(a) Apply engine oil to the upper bearing and install the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(b) Install the 2 upper thrust washers to the No. 2 journal
position of the cylinder block.
(1) Push the crankshaft toward the front (rear) side.
(2) Install the 2 upper thrust washers with the oil
grooves facing outward.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(c) Install the 2 lower thrust washers on the No. 2 bearing
cap with the grooves facing outward.
(d) Examine the front marks and numbers and install the
bearing caps on the cylinder block.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f) Temporarily install the 8 main bearing cap bolts to the inside positions.
(g) Install the main bearing caps. Tighten the 2 bolts for
each bearing cap until the clearance between the bearing
cap and the cylinder block becomes less than 6 mm
(0.23 in.).
(h) Using a plastic-faced hammer, lightly tap the bearing
cap to ensure a proper fit.
(i) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the main bearing cap bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(j) Install the 16 main bearing cap bolts. Using several
steps, tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 61 N·m (622 kgf·cm, 45 ft·lbf)
(k) Mark the front side of the bearing cap bolts with paint.
(l) Retighten the bearing cap bolts 90° in the sequence as shown.
(m) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the front.
(n) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
(o) Using several steps, tighten the 8 main bearing cap bolts
uniformly in the sequence as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 26 N·m (262 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
13. INSTALL PISTON SUB-ASSEMBLY WITH CONNECTING ROD
(a) Apply engine oil to the cylinder walls, the pistons, and
the surfaces of the connecting rod bearings.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Check the positions of the piston ring ends.
(c) Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies
into each cylinder with the front mark of the piston facing forward.
NOTICE:
z
z
Clean the backside of the bearing and the contact surface of the connecting rod cap and prevent oil
from adhering to them.
Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the connecting rod.
(d) Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is
facing the correct direction.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
(f) Tighten the bolts alternately with the specified torque.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(g) Mark the front side of each connecting cap bolt with
paint.
(h) Retighten the cap bolts 90° as shown.
(i) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
14. INSTALL RING PIN
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in new ring pins until it reaches the specified protrusion height.
Specified protrusion height:
2.7 to 3.3 mm (0.106 to 0.130 in.)
15. INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in new straight pins until it reaches the specified protrusion
height.
Specified protrusion height:
A
17.5 to 19.5 mm (0.689 to 0.768 in.)
B
7.5 to 8.5 mm (0.295 to 0.335 in.)
C
7.0 to 9.0 mm (0.276 to 0.354 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
16. INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Using the torx socket wrench E5 and E7, install the stud bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 4.0 N·m (41 kgf·cm, 35 in·lbf)
Torque: 20 N·m (199 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
17. INSTALL UNION
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or
Equivalent
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Using a deep socket wrench 12, install the unions.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
18. INSTALL TIGHT PLUG
(a) Apply adhesive around the tight plug.
(b) Using SST, tap in the tight plugs to the specified depth.
SST: 09950-60010
09951-00250
SST: 09950-70010
09951-07150
Specified depth:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
19. INSTALL WITH HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG
(a) Using a straight hexagon wrench 14, install a new gasket and straight screw plug.
Torque: 80 N·m (816 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
20. INSTALL VALVE STEM OIL O SEAL OR RING
HINT:
The intake valve stem oil seal is light brown and the exhaust valve stem oil seal is gray.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the valve guide bush.
(b) Using SST, push in a new valve stem oil seal.
SST: 09201-41020
21. INSTALL VALVE SPRING SEAT
(a) Install the valve spring seat.
22. INSTALL VALVE
(a) Apply engine oil to the valve as shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Place the cylinder head on a wooden block.
(c) Install the valve, inner compression spring and valve spring retainer.
(d) Using SST, compress the inner compression spring and place the 2 valve spring retainer locks
around the valve stem.
SST: 09202-70020
09202-00010
(e) Using a pin punch 5, lightly tap the valve stem tip to
ensure a proper fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve stem tip.
23. INSTALL VALVE LIFTER
(a) Apply engine oil to the valve stem end and valve lifter,
and install the valve lifter to the valve stem.
(b) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
24. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST: 09223-78010
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
25. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the oil seal retainer and cylinder block.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)) to the oil seal retainer as
shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of
application. Otherwise the seal packing must be
removed and reapplied.
(c) Install the oil seal retainer with the 5 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
26. INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Install the 2 knock sensors with the 2 bolts as shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 20 N·m (204 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Connect the knock sensor connectors.
27. INSTALL NO. 1 WATER OUTLET PIPE
(a) Install the water outlet pipe with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
28. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Apply seal packing (diameter: 2.5 to 3 mm (0.098 to
0.118 in.)) to a new cylinder head gasket as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head bolts must be tightened within 15 minutes.
Otherwise the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
(c) Place the cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
surface with the Lot No. stamp upper side facing upward.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful of the installation direction.
Place the cylinder head carefully in order not to damage
the gasket with the bottom part of the head.
29. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the RH cylinder head on the cylinder head gasket.
(b) Install the 8 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
HINT:
z
z
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive steps (procedures "A" and "B").
If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed, replace it.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
(2) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
(3) Using several steps, tighten each bolt with a 10 mm
bi-hexagon wrench uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration (Procedure "A").
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the cylinder head
bolt.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
Do not drop the washers into the cylinder head.
(4) Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt with
paint.
(5) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 180° as shown (Procedure "B").
(6) Check that the painted marks are now at 180° opposite to the engine front.
30. INSTALL NO. 2 CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Apply seal packing (diameter: 2.5 to 3 mm (0.098 to
0.118 in.)) to a new cylinder head gasket as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head bolts must be tightened within 15 minutes.
Otherwise the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
(c) Place the cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
surface with the Lot No. stamp upper side facing upward.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful of the installation direction.
Place the cylinder head carefully in order not to damage
the gasket with the bottom part of the head.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
31. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD LH
(a) Place the LH cylinder head on the cylinder head gasket.
(b) Install the 8 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
HINT:
z
z
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive steps (procedures "A" and "B").
If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed, replace it.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
(2) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
(3) Using several steps, tighten each bolt with a 10 mm
bi-hexagon wrench uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration (Procedure "A").
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet
the torque specification, replace the cylinder head
bolt.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the washers into the cylinder head.
(4) Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt with
paint.
(5) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 180° as shown (Procedure "B").
(6) Check that the painted marks are now at 180° opposite to the engine front.
(c) Install the 2 cylinder head bolts.
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
cylinder head bolts.
(2) Install the 2 cylinder head bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 30 N·m (306 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
32. INSTALL NO. 1 CAMSHAFT BEARING
(a) Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the
bearing cap, and push in the camshaft bearing.
NOTICE:
z
z
Install the bearing while aligning it with the oil hole in
the bearing cap.
Clean the backside of the bearing and the contact
surface of the bearing cap and prevent oil from adhering
to them.
33. INSTALL NO. 2 CAMSHAFT BEARING
(a) Install the No. 2 camshaft bearing to the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Clean the backside of the bearing and the bearing
surface of the cylinder head.
34. INSTALL CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(a) Set the crankshaft position.
(1) Using the crankshaft pulley set bolt, turn the
crankshaft, and set the crankshaft set key into the
left horizontal position.
NOTICE:
Having the crankshaft at the wrong angle can cause the
piston head and valve head to come into contact with
each other when you install the camshaft, causing
damage. So always set the crankshaft at the correct
angle.
(b) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshafts.
(c) Install the camshaft of the RH bank.
(1) Place the 2 camshafts onto the RH cylinder head with
the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder facing each direction
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
as shown in the illustration.
(2) Install the 8 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(3) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
bearing cap bolts.
(4) Install the 16 bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(5) Turn the camshafts clockwise with a wrench until the
camshaft knock pin comes 90° position to the
cylinder head.
(d) Install the camshafts of the LH bank.
(1) Place the 2 camshafts onto the LH cylinder head with
the cam lobes of No. 2 cylinder facing as shown in
the illustration.
(2) Install the 8 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(3) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(4) Install the 16 bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
35. INSTALL NO. 2 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0 mm
(0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Install the No. 2 chain tensioner with the bolt.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
36. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 1)
(a) Align the mark links (yellow) with the timing marks (1dot mark) of the camshaft timing gears as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Align the timing marks on the camshaft timing gears
with the timing marks on the bearing caps, and install
the camshaft timing gears with the chain to the RH
camshafts.
(c) Temporarily install the 2 camshaft timing gear bolts.
NOTICE:
Do not push the camshaft timing gear assembly to the camshaft forcibly when installing it.
(d) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(e) Remove the pin from the No. 2 chain tensioner.
37. INSTALL NO. 3 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0 mm
(0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(b) Install the No. 3 chain tensioner with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
38. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEARS AND NO. 2 CHAIN (for Bank 2)
(a) Align the mark links (yellow) with the timing marks (1dot mark and 2-dot mark) of the camshaft timing gears
as shown in the illustration.
(b) Align the timing marks on the camshaft timing gears
with the timing marks on the bearing caps, and install
the camshaft timing gears with the chain to the LH
camshafts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(c) Temporarily install the 2 camshaft timing gear bolts.
NOTICE:
Do not push the camshaft timing gear assembly to the camshaft forcibly when installing it.
(d) Hold the hexagonal portion of the camshaft with a
wrench, and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the pin from the No. 3 chain tensioner.
39. INSTALL NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Install the No. 1 chain vibration damper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
40. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
(a) Align the timing gear set key with the key groove of the
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
timing gear.
(b) Install the timing gear onto the crankshaft with the gear facing inward as shown in the illustration.
41. INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
42. INSTALL NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the tensioner as shown
in the illustration.
(b) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(c) Install the chain tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
43. INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to the TDC / compression.
(1) Align the timing marks of the camshaft timing gears
and bearing caps.
(2) Install the crankshaft pulley set bolt, and turn the
crankshaft to align the crankshaft set key with the
timing line of the cylinder block.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Align the mark link (yellow) with the timing mark of the
crankshaft timing gear.
(c) Align the mark links (orange) with the timing marks of
the camshaft timing gears, and install the chain.
44. INSTALL NO. 2 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Instal the 2 No. 2 chain vibration dampers.
45. INSTALL NO. 1 IDLE GEAR SHAFT
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the rotating surface of the No. 1 idle gear shaft.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Temporarily install the No. 1 idle gear shaft and No. 1
idle gear with the No. 2 idle gear shaft while aligning the
knock pin of the No. 1 idle gear shaft with the knock pin
groove of the cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the idle gear direction.
(c) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, tighten the No. 2 idle gear shaft.
Torque: 60 N·m (612 kgf·cm, 44 ft·lbf)
(d) Remove the bar from the chain tensioner.
46. INSTALL TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the timing chain cover edge.
SST: 09226-10010
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
47. INSTALL TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the timing chain cover, cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Install a new O-ring to the LH cylinder head as shown in
the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(c) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter 3.0
to 4.0 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) to 4 locations as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
(d) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter 3.0
to 4.0 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) to the timing chain cover
as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Water pump part
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B
or Equivalent
Other part
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
z
z
Install the timing chain cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the timing chain
cover bolts and nuts must be tightened within 15
minutes. Otherwise the seal packing must be removed
and reapplied.
Do not apply seal packing to the "A" as shown in the
illustration.
(e) Align the key way of the oil pump drive rotor with the
rectangular portion of the crankshaft timing gear, and
slide the timing chain cover into place.
(f) Install the timing chain cover with the 15 bolts and 2
nuts. Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several
steps.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 23 N·m (235 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
z
z
Pay attention not to wrap the chain and slipper over the
timing chain cover seal line.
After installing the timing chain cover, install the water
pump within 15 minutes.
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
HINT:
A: 25 mm (0.98 in.)
HINT:
B: 55 mm (2.17 in.)
48. INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 17
bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 23 N·m (235 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
49. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder block, rear oil seal retainer and oil pan.
(b) Install the 4 stud bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 4.0 N·m (41 kgf·cm, 35 in·lbf)
(c) Install a new O-ring to the oil pump.
(d) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 3 to
4 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) to the oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the oil pan within 3 minutes after applying seal
packing. After installing it, the oil pan bolts and nuts
must be tightened within 15 minutes. Otherwise the
seal packing must be removed and reapplied.
(e) Install the oil pan with the 17 bolts and 2 nuts. Tighten
the bolts and nuts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
HINT:
A: 25 mm (0.98 in.)
HINT:
B: 45 mm (1.77 in.)
HINT:
C: 14 mm (0.55 in.)
50. INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
51. INSTALL NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the oil pan and No. 2 oil pan.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 3 to
4 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the No. 2 oil pan within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing. After installing it, the No. 2 oil pan bolts
and nuts must be tightened within 15 minutes.
Otherwise the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(c) Install the No. 2 oil pan with the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
52. INSTALL OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
(a) Install the drain plug and a new gasket.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
53. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, install the pulley set bolt.
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
Torque: 250 N·m (2,549 kgf·cm, 184 ft·lbf)
54. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
55. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
56. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
57. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head, timing chain cover and cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)) to the cylinder head and timing
chain cover as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing::
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Install the cylinder head cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head cover bolts and nuts must be tightened within 15
minutes. Otherwise the seal packing must be removed
and reapplied.
(c) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(d) Install the seal washers to the bolts.
(e) Install the cylinder head cover with the 10 bolts and 2
nuts. Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several
steps.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
58. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder head, timing chain cover and cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply adhesive to the threads of the ventilation valve.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
(c) Install the ventilation valve to the cylinder head cover.
Torque: 27 N·m (275 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
(d) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)) to the cylinder head and timing
chain cover as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder head cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing. After installing it, the cylinder
head cover bolts and nuts must be tightened within 15
minutes. Otherwise the seal packing must be removed
and reapplied.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(e) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(f) Install the seal washers to the bolts.
(g) Install the cylinder head cover with the 10 bolts and 2
nuts. Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several
steps.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
59. INSTALL OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
(a) Check that no foreign objects are present on the mesh
part of the 2 filters.
(b) Install 2 new gaskets to each new plug.
(c) Insert the filters to the plugs.
(d) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the plugs.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
(e) Install the plugs to each cylinder head.
Torque: 62 N·m (632 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
60. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install the crankshaft position sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
61. INSTALL VVT SENSOR
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the O-ring of each VVT sensor.
(b) Install the 2 VVT sensors with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in·lbf)
62. INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the drain cocks end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or
Equivalent
(b) After applying the specified torque, rotate the drain cock
clockwise as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 25 N·m (255 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
Install the drain cock within 3 minutes after applying
adhesive.
Do not expose the drain cock to coolant within 1 hour
after installing.
Do not rotate the drain cock by more than 1 revolution
(360°) after tightening the drain cock with the specified
torque.
Do not loosen the drain cock after setting it correctly.
63. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Install a new O-ring to the oil level gauge guide.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the O-ring.
(c) Push in the oil level gauge guide end into the guide hole of the oil pan.
(d) Install the oil level gauge guide with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
64. INSTALL NO. 2 ENGINE HANGER
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE UNIT: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the engine hanger with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 33 N·m (336 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
65. INSTALL NO. 1 ENGINE HANGER
(a) Install the engine hanger with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 33 N·m (336 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017L8004X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT
HINT:
2. INSPECT ENGINE OIL
HINT:
3. INSPECT BATTERY
HINT:
4. INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSEMBLY
5. INSPECT DRIVE BELT
6. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
NOTICE:
z
Turn all electrical systems OFF.
z
Operate the inspection when the cooling fan motor is turned OFF.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) When using the intelligent tester.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / DATA LIST / IGN ADVANCE.
(3) Inspect the ignition timing during idling.
Ignition timing:
7 to 24°CA BTDC during idling (Transmission in neutral
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
position)
(4) Check that the ignition timing advances immediately
when the engine speed is increased.
(c) When not using intelligent tester.
(1) Using SST, connect the terminals 13 (TC) and 4 (CG)
of the DLC3.
SST: 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Be sure not to connect the terminals wrongly. It causes
breakage of the engine.
(2) Remove the air cleaner cap sub-assembly.
(3) Pull out the wire harness as shown in the illustration.
(4) Connect the tester probe of a timing light to the wire
of the ignition coil connector for No. 1 cylinder.
NOTICE:
z
z
Use a timing light that detects the first signal.
After checking, be sure to wrap the wire harness with
tape.
(5) Inspect the ignition timing during idling.
Ignition timing:
8 to 12°CA BTDC during idling (Transmission in neutral
position)
(6) Remove the SST from the DLC3.
(7) Inspect the ignition timing during idling.
Ignition timing:
7 to 24°CA BTDC during idling (Transmission in neutral
position)
(8) Disconnect the timing light from the engine.
(9) Install the air cleaner cap sub-assembly.
7. INSPECT ENGINE IDLING SPEED
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
z
Turn all the electrical systems OFF.
z
Operate the inspection when the cooling fan motor is turned OFF.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) When using the intelligent tester:
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / DATA LIST / ENGINE SPD.
(3) Inspect the engine idling speed.
Idling speed:
650 to 750 rpm (Transmission in neutral position)
(c) When not using the intelligent tester:
(1) Using SST, connect the terminal 8 (TAC) of the
DLC3.
SST: 09843-18030
(2) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for
approximately 90 seconds.
(3) Inspect the engine idling speed.
Idling speed:
650 to 750 rpm (Transmission in neutral position)
8. INSPECT COMPRESSION
(a) Warm up and stop the engine.
(b) Remove the V-bank cover.
(c) Remove the air cleaner assembly.
(d) Remove the intake air surge tank
.
(e) Remove the 6 ignition coils.
(f) Remove the 6 spark plugs.
(g) Disconnect the 6 injector connectors.
(h) Inspect the cylinder compression pressure.
(1) Insert a compression gage into the spark plug hole
(Procedure "A").
SST: 09992-00500
(2) Fully open the throttle (Procedure "B").
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(3) While cranking the engine, measure the compression
pressure (Procedure "C").
Compression pressure:
1,300 kPa (13.3 kgf/cm 2, 189 psi)
Minimum pressure:
1,000 kPa (10.2 kgf/cm 2, 145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm 2, 15 psi)
NOTICE:
z
z
z
Use a fully-charged battery so the engine speed can be
increased to 250 rpm or more.
Inspect the other cylinders in the same way.
Measure the compression in as short a time as possible.
(4) Repeat procedures "A" through "C" for each cylinder.
(5) If the cylinder compression is low, pour a small
amount of engine oil into the cylinder through the
spark plug hole and repeat procedures "A" through
"C" for cylinders with low compression.
z
z
If adding oil increases the compression, the piston
rings and/or cylinder bore may be worn or
damaged.
If pressure stays low, a valve may be stuck or
seated improperly, or there may be leakage from
the gasket.
(i) Connect the 6 injector connectors.
(j) Install the 6 spark plugs.
(k) Install the 6 ignition coils.
(l) Install the intake air surge tank
.
(m) Install the air cleaner assembly.
(n) Install the V-bank cover.
9. INSPECT CO/HC
HINT:
This check is to determine whether or not the idle CO/HC complies with regulations.
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 180 seconds.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Insert the CO/HC meter testing probe at least 40 cm
(1.3 ft) into the tailpipe during idling.
(d) Immediately check the CO/HC concentration during idling and/or at 2,500 rpm.
HINT:
z
z
Complete the measurement within 3 minutes.
When carrying out the 2 modes (idling and 2,500 rpm) test, the measurement orders are
prescribed by the applicable local regulations.
(e) If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with regulations, troubleshoot in the order given
below.
(1) Check the A/F sensor and heated oxygen sensor operation.
(2) See the table below for possible causes, then inspect and correct the applicable causes if
necessary.
CO
HC
SYMPTOM
CAUSES
1. Faulty ignition:
{
Normal
High Rough idling
{
Incorrect timing
Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaky intake and exhaust valves
4. Leaky cylinders
1. Vacuum leaks:
Low
High
Rough idling
{
(Fluctuating HC reading)
{
{
PCV hoses
Intake manifold
Throttle body
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
High
High
Rough idling
(Black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Faulty EFI systems:
{
Faulty pressure regulator
Faulty engine coolant temperature sensor
Faulty mass air flow meter
{
Faulty ECM
{
{
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: ENGINE: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
{
{
Faulty injectors
Faulty throttle position sensor
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029WU002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029WS002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
2. INSTALL NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the tensioner as shown
in the illustration.
(b) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(c) Install the chain tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
3. INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to the TDC / compression.
(1) Align the timing marks of the camshaft timing gears
and bearing caps.
(2) Install the crankshaft pulley set bolt, and turn the
crankshaft to align the crankshaft set key with the
timing line of the cylinder block.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Align the mark link (yellow) with the timing mark of the
crankshaft timing gear.
(c) Align the mark links (orange) with the timing marks of
the camshaft timing gears, and install the chain.
4. INSTALL NO. 2 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Instal the 2 No. 2 chain vibration dampers.
5. INSTALL NO. 1 IDLE GEAR SHAFT
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the rotating surface of the No. 1 idle gear shaft.
(b) Temporarily install the No. 1 idle gear shaft and No. 1
idle gear with the No. 2 idle gear shaft while aligning the
knock pin of the No. 1 idle gear shaft with the knock pin
groove of the cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the idle gear direction.
(c) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, tighten the No. 2 idle gear shaft.
Torque: 60 N·m (612 kgf·cm, 44 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(d) Remove the bar from the chain tensioner.
6. INSTALL TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
7. INSTALL TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
8. INSTALL VVT SENSOR
9. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the camshaft timing oil control valves to each cylinder head, and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
10. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
11. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
13. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
14. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the cylinder block, rear oil seal retainer and oil pan.
(b) Install a new O-ring to the oil pump.
(c) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter: 3 to
4 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) to the oil pan as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the oil pan within 3 minutes after applying seal
packing. After installing it, the oil pan bolts and nuts
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
must be tightened within 15 minutes. Otherwise the
seal packing must be removed and reapplied.
(d) Install the oil pan with the 17 bolts and 2 nuts. Tighten
the bolts and nuts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
HINT:
A: 25 mm (0.98 in.)
HINT:
B: 45 mm (1.77 in.)
HINT:
C: 14 mm (0.55 in.)
(e) Install the 4 housing bolts.
Torque: 37 N·m (377 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(f) Install the flywheel housing under cover.
15. INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
16. INSTALL NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces
of the oil pan and No. 2 oil pan.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (diameter 3: to
4 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the No. 2 oil pan within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing. After installing it, the No. 2 oil pan bolts
and nuts must be tightened within 15 minutes.
Otherwise the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
(c) Install the No. 2 oil pan with the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
17. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, install the pulley set bolt.
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
Torque: 250 N·m (2,549 kgf·cm, 184 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
18. INSTALL NO. 1 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the idler pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 54 N·m (551 kgf·cm, 40 ft·lbf)
HINT:
"DOUBLE" is marked on the No. 1 idler pulley to distinguish it
from the No. 2 idler pulley.
19. INSTALL NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 idler pulleys with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (398 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
20. INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Temporarily install the V-ribbed belt tensioner with the 5
bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Install the V-ribbed belt tensioner by tightening the bolt 1 and bolt 2 in the order shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(c) Tighten the other bolts.
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
A: 70 mm (2.76 in.)
B: 33 mm (1.30 in.)
21. INSTALL COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
22. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
23. INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the vane pump with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (438 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not hit the pulley to other parts when installing the
vane pump.
(b) Connect the P/S oil pressure switch connector.
24. INSTALL WATER INLET
25. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Install a new O-ring to the oil level gauge guide.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the O-ring.
(c) Push in the oil level gauge guide end into the guide hole of the oil pan.
(d) Install the oil level gauge guide with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
(e) Install the oil level gauge.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
26. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
27. CONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
28. INSTALL FLUID COUPLING ASSEMBLY
29. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
30. FULLY TIGHTEN FLUID COUPLING ASSEMBLY
31. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
32. INSTALL BATTERY
33. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY FRONT
HINT:
34. INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
HINT:
35. ADD ENGINE OIL
36. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
37. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
38. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
39. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
40. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029WT002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
HINT:
2. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY FRONT (for 4WD)
HINT:
3. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
4. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
5. REMOVE BATTERY
6. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
7. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support seal upper.
8. LOOSEN FLUID COUPLING ASSEMBLY
9. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
10. REMOVE FLUID COUPLING ASSEMBLY
11. DISCONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
12. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
13. REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Remove the oil level gauge.
(b) Remove the bolt and pull out the oil level gauge guide.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(c) Remove the O-ring from the oil level gauge guide.
14. REMOVE WATER INLET
15. SEPARATE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the P/S oil pressure switch connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, and separate the vane pump.
NOTICE:
Do not hit the pulley to other parts when separating the vane pump.
HINT:
The vane pump is suspended securely.
16. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
17. SEPARATE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
18. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and V-ribbed belt tensioner.
19. REMOVE NO. 2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 idler pulleys.
20. REMOVE NO. 1 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
21. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and loosen the
pulley set bolt.
SST: 09213-54015
91651-60855
SST: 09330-00021
(b) Using the pulley set bolt and SST, remove the
crankshaft pulley.
SST: 09950-50013
09951-05010
09952-05010
09953-05020
09954-05030
22. REMOVE NO. 2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Insert the blade of SST between the oil pan and No. 2 oil
pan, cut off applied sealer and remove the No. 2 oil pan.
SST: 09032-00100
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the oil
pan and No. 2 oil pan.
Be careful not to damage the No. 2 oil pan flange.
23. REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
24. REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 housing bolts.
(b) Remove the flywheel housing under cover.
(c) Remove the 17 bolts and 2 nuts.
(d) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying
between the oil pan and cylinder block as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
cylinder block and oil pan.
(e) Remove the O-ring from the oil pump.
25. REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
26. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
27. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
28. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
29. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 oil control valve connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 camshaft timing oil control valves.
30. REMOVE VVT SENSOR
31. REMOVE TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
32. REMOVE TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL
33. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the crankshaft pulley set bolt, and turn the
crankshaft to align the crankshaft set key with the timing
line of the cylinder block.
(b) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the bearing
caps as shown in the illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution (360°)
and align the timing marks as above.
34. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
z
z
Never rotate the crankshaft with the chain tensioner removed.
When rotating the camshaft with the timing chain removed, rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise
40° from the TDC first.
(a) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the chain tensioner as
shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: TIMING CHAIN: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(b) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
35. REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
36. REMOVE NO. 1 IDLE GEAR SHAFT
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the No. 2 idle
gear shaft, No. 1 idle gear and No. 1 idle gear shaft.
37. REMOVE NO. 2 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Remove the 2 No. 2 chain vibration dampers.
38. REMOVE CHAIN SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 N
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Mechanical
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029VW002X
Title: 1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
ADJUSTMENT
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
3. DISCONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
4. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
5. REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
6. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
7. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
8. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
9. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
(a) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align the notch with the
timing mark "0" of the timing chain cover.
(b) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the bearing
caps as shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution (360°)
and align the timing marks as above.
10. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Check the valves indicated in the illustration.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.29 to 0.39 mm (0.011 to 0.015 in.)
(2) Record the out-of-specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement valve lifter.
(b) Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and
check the valves indicated in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.29 to 0.39 mm (0.011 to 0.015 in.)
(2) Record the out-of-specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement valve lifter.
(c) Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and
check the valves indicated in the illustration.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.29 to 0.39 mm (0.011 to 0.015 in.)
(2) Record the out-of-specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement valve lifter.
11. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to the TDC /compression.
(1) Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align the notch with
the timing mark "0" of the timing chain cover.
(2) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
bearing caps as shown in the illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°) and align the timing marks as above.
(3) Place paint marks on the No. 1 chain links that
correspond with the timing marks of the camshaft
timing gears.
(b) Remove the No. 1 chain tensioner assembly.
NOTICE:
z
z
Never rotate the crankshaft with the chain tensioner removed.
When rotating the camshaft with the timing chain removed, turn the crankshaft counterclockwise
40° from the TDC first.
(1) Remove the 4 bolts, timing chain cover plate and
gasket.
(2) While rotating the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the chain tensioner
as shown in the illustration.
(3) While rotating the stopper plate of the tensioner counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm
(0.138 in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner to fix the stopper plate.
(4) Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
(c) Remove the No. 2 camshaft.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) While raising the No. 2 chain tensioner, insert a pin
of φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(2) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 2 camshaft
with a wrench, and remove the camshaft timing gear
set bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
(3) Separate the camshaft timing gear from the No. 2 camshaft.
(4) Rotate the camshaft counterclockwise using a wrench
so that the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder face upward
as shown in the illustration.
(5) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration.
(6) Remove the 4 bearing caps and No. 2 camshaft.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(d) Remove the No. 2 chain tensioner assembly.
(1) Remove the No. 2 chain tensioner bolt, and then
remove the No. 2 chain tensioner and camshaft
timing gear.
(e) Remove the camshaft.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 1 camshaft
with a wrench, and loosen the camshaft timing gear
set bolt.
NOTICE:
z
z
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
Do not disassemble the camshaft timing gear assembly.
(2) Slide the camshaft timing gear and separate the No.
1 chain from the camshaft timing gear.
(3) Rotate the No. 1 camshaft counterclockwise using a
wrench so that the cam lobes of the No. 1 cylinder
face upward as shown in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(4) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration.
(5) Remove the 4 bearing caps.
(6) Remove the camshaft timing gear set bolt with the
No. 1 camshaft lifted up, and then remove the No. 1
camshaft and camshaft timing gear with No. 2 chain.
(7) Tie the No. 1 chain with a string as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing chain
cover.
(f) Remove the No. 4 camshaft sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) While pushing down the No. 3 chain tensioner, insert
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
a pin of φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(2) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 4 camshaft
with a wrench, and remove the camshaft timing gear
set bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head and valve
lifter with the wrench.
(3) Separate the camshaft timing gear from the No. 4 camshaft.
(4) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration.
(5) Remove the 4 bearing caps and No. 4 camshaft.
(g) Remove the No. 3 chain tensioner assembly.
(1) Remove the No. 3 chain tensioner bolt, and then
remove the No. 3 chain tensioner and camshaft
timing gear.
(h) Remove the No. 3 camshaft sub-assembly.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) Using several steps, loosen and remove the 8
bearing cap bolts uniformly in the sequence as
shown in the illustration.
(2) Remove the 4 bearing caps.
(3) Hold the No. 1 chain, and remove the No. 3
camshaft, camshaft timing gear and No. 2 chain.
(4) Tie the No. 1 chain with a string as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing chain
cover.
(i) Remove the valve lifters.
(j) Determine the size of the valve lifter to be installed
according to the following formulas or charts.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the
removed lifter.
(2) Calculate the thickness of a new lifter so that the
valve clearance comes within the specified value.
T:
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
Thickness of removed lifter
A:
Measured valve clearance
N:
Thickness of new lifter
Intake:
N = T + (A - 0.20 mm (0.008 in.))
Exhaust:
N = T + (A - 0.30 mm (0.012 in.))
(3) Select a new lifter with a thickness as close as
possible to the calculated value.
HINT:
Lifters are available in 35 sizes in increments of 0.020 mm
(0.0008 in.), from 5.060 mm (0.1992 in.) to 5.740 mm
(0.2260 in.).
(k) Install the No. 3 camshaft sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) Align the mark link (yellow) with the timing mark (2dot mark) of the camshaft timing gear as shown in
the illustration.
(2) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portions and journals of the camshafts.
(3) Temporarily put the No. 1 chain on the No. 2 chain of
the camshaft timing gear.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(4) Set the No. 3 camshaft onto the LH cylinder head
with the cam lobes of the No. 2 cylinder facing
downward as shown in the illustration.
(5) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(6) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(7) Install the 8 bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(8) Set the paint mark of the No. 1 chain between the
timing marks of the camshaft timing gear.
(l) Install the No. 3 chain tensioner assembly.
(1) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
(2) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear and No.
3 chain tensioner and align the mark links (yellow)
with the timing marks (1-dot mark and 2-dot mark)
of the camshaft timing gears.
(3) Tighten the No. 3 chain tensioner bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(m) Install the No. 4 camshaft sub-assembly.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) Align the knock pin hole on the camshaft timing gear
with the knock pin of the No. 4 camshaft, and insert
the No. 4 camshaft into the camshaft timing gear.
(2) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
(3) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(4) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(5) Install the 8 bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(6) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 4 camshaft
with a wrench, and tighten the camshaft timing gear
set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(7) Remove the pin from the No. 3 chain tensioner.
(n) Install the camshaft.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) Align the mark link (yellow) with the timing mark (1dot mark) of the camshaft timing gear as shown in
the illustration.
(2) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portions and journals of the camshafts.
(3) Temporarily put the No. 1 chain on the No. 2 chain of
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
the camshaft timing gear.
(4) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing gear
with the knock pin of the No. 1 camshaft, and insert
the No. 1 camshaft into the camshaft timing gear.
(5) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear set bolt.
(6) Set the No. 1 camshaft onto the RH cylinder head
with the cam lobes of the No. 1 cylinder facing
downward as shown in the illustration.
(7) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(8) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(9) Install the 8 bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(10) Rotate the No. 1 camshaft clockwise using the
hexagonal portion of the No. 1 camshaft so that the
timing mark of the camshaft timing gear is aligned
with the timing mark of the camshaft bearing cap.
(11) Align the paint mark of the No. 1 chain with the
timing mark of the camshaft timing gear.
(12) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 1 camshaft
with a wrench, and tighten the camshaft timing gear
set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(o) Install the No. 2 chain tensioner assembly.
(1) While pushing in the tensioner, insert a pin of φ1.0
mm (0.039 in.) into the hole to fix it.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(2) Temporarily install the camshaft timing gear and No.
2 chain tensioner and align the mark links (yellow)
with the timing marks (1-dot mark) of the camshaft
timing gears.
(3) Tighten the No. 2 chain tensioner bolt.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(p) Install the No. 2 camshaft.
NOTICE:
As the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level while it is
being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head which receives
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
the following steps should be carried out.
(1) Set the No. 2 camshaft onto the RH cylinder head
with the cam lobes of No. 1 cylinder facing upward as
shown in the illustration.
(2) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(3) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(4) Install the 8 bearing cap bolts. Using several steps,
tighten the bolts uniformly in the sequence as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(5) Rotate the No. 2 camshaft clockwise using a wrench
so that the knock pin of the No. 2 camshaft is aligned
with the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing gear.
(6) Hold the hexagonal portion of the No. 2 camshaft
with a wrench, and install the camshaft timing gear
set bolt.
Torque: 100 N·m (1,020 kgf·cm, 74 ft·lbf)
(7) Remove the pin from the No. 2 chain tensioner.
(q) Install the No. 1 chain tensioner assembly.
(1) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
clockwise, push in the plunger of the tensioner as
shown in the illustration.
(2) While turning the stopper plate of the tensioner
counterclockwise, insert a bar of φ3.5 mm (0.138
in.) into the holes on the stopper plate and tensioner
to fix the stopper plate.
(3) Install the chain tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(4) Remove the bar from the chain tensioner.
1GR-FE ENGINE MECHANICAL: VALVE CLEARANCE: ADJUSTMENT (2007 4Runner)
(5) Install a new gasket and the timing chain cover plate
with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
(6) Turn the crankshaft pulley 2 complete revolutions
slowly, and align the notch with the timing mark "0"
of the timing chain cover.
(7) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
gears are aligned with the timing marks of the
bearing caps as shown in the illustration.
12. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
13. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
14. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
15. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
16. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
17. CONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
18. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
19. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
20. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
21. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Intake/Exhaust
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002B1I001X
1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Intake/Exhaust
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B1H001X
Title: 1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 2)
(a) Install the heated oxygen sensor to the exhaust pipe front.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
HINT:
After installing heated oxygen sensor, check that sensor wire is not twisted. If it is twisted, remove
the heated oxygen sensor and reinstall it.
2. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Install a new gasket and the front pipe to the exhaust manifold.
(b) Install the exhaust pipe front with 2 nuts.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
3. INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1)
(a) Install the heated oxygen sensor to the exhaust pipe front.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
HINT:
After installing heated oxygen sensor, check that sensor wire is not twisted. If it is twisted, remove
the heated oxygen sensor and reinstall it.
4. INSTALL NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install 2 new gaskets and the front pipe to the exhaust manifold.
(b) Install the exhaust pipe front with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
5. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY CENTER
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length to the
1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
compression spring.
Minimum length:
40.5 mm (4.5645 in.)
If the free length is less than minimum, replace the
compression spring.
(b) Install a new gasket on the exhaust pipe assembly front.
(c) Install the exhaust pipe assembly center with the 2 bolts and 2 springs.
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
6. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY TAIL
(a) Install a new gasket on the exhaust pipe center.
(b) Install the tail pipe with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
7. INSPECT EXHAUST GAS LEAK
1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Intake/Exhaust
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B1J001X
Title: 1GR-FE EXHAUST: EXHAUST PIPE: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY TAIL
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, exhaust pipe support and tail pipe.
2. REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY CENTER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
(b) Remove the 4 exhaust pipe supports and exhaust pipe center.
3. REMOVE NO. 2 EXHAUST FRONT PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and No. 2 exhaust front pipe assembly.
4. REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1)
(a) Disconnect a heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Remove the heated oxygen sensor.
5. REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY FRONT
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and exhaust pipe assembly front.
6. REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 2)
(a) Disconnect a heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Remove the heated oxygen sensor.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000000PE200UX
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000WQQ00UX
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
TESTER CONNECTION
SPECIFIED CONDITION
1-2
11.6 to 12.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuel injector.
(b) Check the injection volume.
NOTICE:
z
z
Perform the test in a well-ventilated area and watch out
for flames.
Handle the fuel tube connector carefully.
(1) Prepare a new fuel tube.
HINT:
Part No. 23801-31070
(2) Using a cutter knife, cut the fuel tube protector. Tear
the protector by hand, then remove the fuel tube
connector.
NOTICE:
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
If the protector is cut too deeply with the cutter, the Oring of the fuel tube connector will be damaged.
(3) Install the fuel tube connector into SST (hose), then
connect the tube connector to the fuel pipe.
SST: 09268-41047
95336-08070
CAUTION:
Connect the fuel tube connector (quick type) after
observing the precautions.
(4) Remove the pressure regulator
.
(5) Install the O-ring onto the fuel inlet of the pressure
regulator.
(6) Connect SST (hose) to the fuel inlet of the pressure
regulator with another SST (union) and the 2 bolts.
SST: 09268-41047
95336-08070
09268-41091
Torque: 7.5 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
(7) Connect the fuel return hose to the fuel outlet of the
pressure regulator.
(8) Install a new O-ring onto the injector.
(9) Connect SST (adaptor and hose) to the injector and
hold the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST: 09268-41047
95336-08070
SST: 09268-41140
SST: 09268-41400
(10) Set the injector in a graduated cylinder.
CAUTION:
Install a suitable vinyl tube onto the injector to prevent
gasoline splashes.
(11) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(12) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(13) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(14) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP /
SPD / ON.
(15) Install SST onto the fuel injector.
SST: 09842-30080
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(16) Connect SST to the battery, then measure the
injection volume for 15 seconds. Perform the
inspection 2 or 3 times, then calculate the average.
Standard::
INJECTION VOLUME
76 to 91 cm 3 (4.6 to 5.5 cu
in.) per 15 seconds
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN EACH
FUEL INJECTOR
15 cm 3 (0.9 cu in.) or less
NOTICE:
Always do the switching at the battery side.
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuel injector.
(c) Check the fuel leakage.
(1) When checking the injection volume, remove SST
from the battery. Inspect the fuel leakage from the
fuel injector.
SST: 09842-30080
Standard:
1 drop or less every 12 minutes.
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuel
injector.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000Q4600VX
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR
(a) Install a new insulator onto each fuel injector.
(b) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to a new O-ring and install it onto each fuel injector.
(c) While turning the fuel injector left and right, install it
onto the fuel delivery pipe.
(d) Position the fuel injector connector facing outward.
2. INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the fuel delivery pipe together with the 6 fuel injectors on the intake manifold.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Provisionally install the 6 bolts, which are used to hold the fuel delivery pipe, onto the intake
manifold.
(c) Check that the fuel injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT:
If the fuel injectors do not rotate smoothly, replace the O-ring.
(d) Position the fuel injector connector facing outward.
(e) Tighten the 6 bolts, which are used to hold the fuel delivery pipe, to the intake manifold.
Torque: 15 N·m (153 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
(f) Connect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
3. CONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Push the tube connector into the pipe until the tube connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
z
z
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the connected part of the fuel pipe.
After connecting, check that the pipe and connector are securely connected by pulling them.
(b) Install the fuel pipe clamp.
4. CONNECT NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Push the tube connector into the pipe until the tube connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
z
z
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the connected part of the fuel pipe.
After connecting, check that the pipe and connector are securely connected by pulling them.
(b) Install the fuel pipe clamp.
5. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
(a) Install a new gasket and the intake air surge tank with
the 2 nuts.
Torque: 28 N·m (286 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
(b) Using an 8 mm socket hexagon wrench, install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 28 N·m (286 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Install the 3 upper bolts which are used to secure the 2
surge tank stays and throttle body bracket.
Torque: 21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the 3 wire harness clamps and hose clamp.
(e) Connect the throttle motor connector.
(f) Connect the 2 VSV connectors.
(g) Connect the ventilation hose.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(h) Connect the fuel vapor feed hose.
(i) Connect the No. 4 water by-pass hose.
(j) Connect the No. 5 water by-pass hose.
6. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7. CONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
(a) Connect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
8. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
9. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
Torque: 3.9 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in·lbf)
10. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
11. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
12. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000Q4800WX
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2. DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
3. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
4. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
5. DISCONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
(a) Disconnect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
6. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7. REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
(a) Disconnect the No. 5 water by-pass hose.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(b) Disconnect the No. 4 water by-pass hose.
(c) Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose.
(d) Disconnect the ventilation hose.
(e) Disconnect the 2 VSV connectors.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(f) Disconnect the throttle motor connector.
(g) Remove the 3 wire harness clamps and hose clamp.
(h) Remove the 3 upper bolts which are used to secure the
2 surge tank stays and throttle body bracket.
(i) Using an 8 mm socket hexagon wrench, remove the 4
bolts.
(j) Remove the 2 nuts, then remove the intake air surge tank and gasket.
8. DISCONNECT NO. 1 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the fuel pipe clamp.
(b) Pinch the tube connector, and then pull the fuel pipe out of the pipe as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
z
z
Remove any dirt and foreign objects from the fuel tube connector before performing this work.
Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects on the parts when disconnecting, as the fuel tube
connector has the O-ring that seals the pipe.
Perform this work by hand. Do not use any tools.
Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the nylon tube.
Protect the disconnected part by covering it with a vinyl bag after disconnecting the fuel tube.
If the fuel tube connector and pipe are stuck, push and pull to release them.
9. DISCONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(a) Remove the fuel pipe clamp.
(b) Pinch the tube connector, and then pull the fuel pipe out of the pipe as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
z
z
Remove any dirt and foreign objects from the fuel tube connector before performing this work.
Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects on the parts when disconnecting, as the fuel tube
connector has the O-ring that seals the pipe.
Perform this work by hand. Do not use any tools.
Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the nylon tube.
Protect the disconnected part by covering it with a vinyl bag after disconnecting the fuel tube.
If the fuel tube connector and pipe are stuck, push and pull to release them.
10. REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and fuel delivery pipe together with the 6 fuel injectors.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the injectors when removing the fuel delivery pipe.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL INJECTOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
11. REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR
(a) Pull the 6 injectors out of the delivery pipe.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028S1002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000UJZ00NX
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to a new O-ring and install it onto the fuel pressure
pulsation damper.
(b) Install the fuel pressure pulsation damper onto the fuel delivery pipe.
(c) Install the clip.
2. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
3. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000UK100NX
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
3. REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE PULSATION DAMPER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Pull the fuel pressure pulsation damper out of the fuel delivery pipe.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028RW002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000015Y3004X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the vacuum hose.
(b) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to a new O-ring and install it onto the fuel pressure
regulator.
(c) Install the fuel pressure regulator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
2. CONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
3. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
4. CONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
(a) Connect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
5. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
6. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
Torque: 3.9 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in·lbf)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
7. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000015Y5004X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
2. DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
3. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
4. DISCONNECT NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
(a) Disconnect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
5. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
6. DISCONNECT NO. 2 FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
7. REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, then remove the fuel pressure regulator.
(b) Remove the vacuum hose.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP RESISTOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028S9002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP RESISTOR: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT FUEL PUMP RESISTOR
(a) Inspect the fuel pump resistor resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminal.
Standard resistance:
0.70 - 0.76 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM0000028S6003X
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028S7003X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the tube joint clip, and pull out the vapor
pressure sensor.
2. REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel sender gage connector.
(b) Unlock the fuel sender gage, and slide it to remove.
3. REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH FILTER
(a) Using a screwdriver, disconnect the 4 snap-claws from
the claw holes, and remove the sub tank.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the sub tank.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(c) Using a small screwdriver, disconnect the 4 claws from
the claw holes, and remove the fuel pump with filter.
(d) Remove the fuel pump O-ring from the fuel pump.
(e) Remove the fuel pump spacer from the fuel pump.
4. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER
(a) Using a small screwdriver, pry out the clip.
(b) Pull out the fuel pump filter from the fuel pump.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028S5003X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT FUEL PUMP
(a) Inspect the fuel pump resistance.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
terminals 4 and 5.
Standard resistance:
0.2 - 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(b) Inspect fuel pump operation.
(1) Apply the battery voltage to both terminals. Check that the pump operates.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds) to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep fuel pump as far away from the battery as possible.
Always do the switching at the battery side.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028S4002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE TUBE ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028S8002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
REASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL FUEL PUMP FILTER
(a) Install the fuel pump filter with a new clip.
2. INSTALL FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH FILTER
(a) Install a fuel pump spacer to the fuel pump.
(b) Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O-ring, and install it to the fuel pump.
(c) Apply a light coat of gasoline to the O-ring again, and install the fuel pump to the fuel filter.
(d) Install the sub tank.
(1) Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O-ring, and
install it to the fuel suction tube assembly.
(2) Apply a light coat of gasoline to the O-ring again, and
install the sub tank to the fuel filter.
3. INSTALL FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSEMBLY
(a) Lock the fuel sender gage.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Connect the fuel sender gage connector.
4. INSTALL VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Install the vapor pressure sensor with the tube joint clip.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
Check that there is no scratch or foreign objects on the
connecting parts.
Check that the fuel tube joint connector is fully inserted.
Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar of the fuel
tub joint.
After installing the tube joint clip, check if the fuel tube
joint connector is securely connected by pulling it.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028T5002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE TUBE ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028RV002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION AND FUEL LEAK
(a) When using the intelligent tester
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and intelligent tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(3) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the intelligent tester.
(4) Please refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for further details.
(b) When not using the intelligent tester
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay.
(2) Using a service wire, connect terminals FP and +B of
the relay block.
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position
to avoid a malfunction.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check that the fuel
pump operates.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance to the fuel system.
(d) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the intelligent tester from the DLC3.
2. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Prepare for inspection.
(1) Prepare a new fuel tube, and take out the fuel tube
connector from the tube.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
HINT:
Part No. 23801-31070
(b) Prevent gasoline from spilling out
.
(c) Disconnect the EFI fuel pipe clamp
.
(d) Disconnect the fuel pipe No. 1 from the fuel main tube.
(e) Install SST (pressure gauge) as shown in the illustration
by using the SSTs and a fuel tube connector.
SST: 09268-31011
90467-13001
95336-08070
SST: 09268-45014
09268-41200
09268-41220
09268-41250
90467-13001
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Start the engine.
(h) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
281 - 287 kPa (2.87 - 2.93 kgf/cm 2, 40.8 - 41.7 psi)
(i) Stop the engine.
(j) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5 minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure:
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm 2, 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(k) After checking the fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery
carefully, remove the SST and fuel tube connector to prevent gasoline from the splashing.
(l) Reconnect the fuel tube to the fuel main tube.
(m) Install the EFI fuel pipe clamp.
(n) Check for fuel leak.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 L
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028RU002X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
PRECAUTION
1. PRECAUTION
(a) Before starting on the work for the fuel system inspection and repair, disconnect the negative (-)
terminal cable from the battery.
(b) Do not smoke or work near fire when handling the fuel system.
(c) Keep gasoline away from rubber or leather parts.
2. WORK FOR PREVENT GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT
CAUTION:
z
z
Take precaution for preventing gasoline from spilling out before removing the fuel system parts.
As there is the remained pressure in the fuel line after working for prevent gasoline from spilling
out, prevent it from splashing inside the vehicle compartment by covering them with a shop rag.
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Start the engine. After the engine stopped, turn the ignition switch OFF.
HINT:
There is a case that DTC P0171 (system to lean) is output.
(c) Check that the engine does not start.
(d) Remove the fuel tank cap, and let the air out of the fuel tank.
(e) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
(f) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
3. FUEL SYSTEM
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
(a) When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a large
amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe these
procedures.
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump tube
.
(2) Drain the fuel remained inside the fuel pump tube.
(3) In order to prevent the disconnected fuel pump tube
from damaging and foreign objects from being mixed
into, cover them with a vinyl bag.
(4) Put a container under the connection.
(b) Observe these precautions when removing and installing
the injectors.
(1) Never reuse the O-ring.
(2) When placing a new O-ring on the injector, do not
damage it.
(3) Coat the new O-rings with spindle oil or gasoline
before installing. Do not use engine oil, gear oil or
brake oil.
(c) Install the injector to the delivery pipe and lower intake
manifold as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Before installing the injector, must apply spindle oil or
gasoline on the place where a delivery pipe or cylinder
head contacts the O-ring of the injector.
(d) Observe these precautions when disconnecting the fuel
tube connector (Quick type A):
(1) Remove the fuel pipe clamp No. 1.
(2) Check that there is no dirt like mud on the pipe and
around the connector before disconnecting them.
Clean them if necessary.
(3) Disconnect them by hand.
(4) When the connector and the pipe are stuck, pinch
the fuel pipe with fingers and push the fuel tube
connector to the fuel pipe by pressing the release
buttons, then pull the connector out from the pipe.
(5) Inspect that there is no dirt or the like on the seal
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
surface of the disconnected pipe. Clean it away if
necessary.
(6) In order to prevent the disconnected pipe and
connector from damaging and foreign objects from
being mixed into, cover them with a vinyl bag.
(e) Observe these precautions when connecting the fuel
tube connector (Quick Type A):
(1) Check that there is no damage or foreign objects in
the connected part of the pipe.
(2) Match the axis of the connector with the axis of the
pipe, and push into the connector until the connector
makes a "click" sound. In case that the connection is
tight, apply a little amount of fresh engine oil on the
tip of the pipe.
(3) After having finished the connection, check if the
pipe and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
(4) Check for any fuel leak.
(f) Observe these precautions when disconnecting the fuel tube connector (Quick type B):
(1) Check if there is any dirt like mud on the pipe and around the connector before disconnecting
them. Clean the dirt away if necessary.
(2) Disconnect them by your hands.
(3) When the connector and the pipe are stuck, push and
pull the connector to free to disconnect and pull it
out. Do not use any tool at this time.
(4) Inspect if there is any dirt or the like on the seal surface of the disconnected pipe. Clean it
away if necessary.
(5) Prevent the disconnected pipe and connector from damaging and foreign objects from being
mixed into by covering them with a vinyl bag.
(g) Observe these precautions when connecting the fuel
tube connector (Quick type B):
(1) Match the axis of the connector with the axis of the
pipe, and push in the connector until the connector
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL SYSTEM: PRECAUTION (2007 4Runner)
makes a "click" sound. In case that the connection is
tight, apply a little amount of new engine oil on the
tip of the pipe.
(2) After having finished the connection, check if the
pipe and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
(3) Check for fuel leakage.
(h) Observe these precautions when handling nylon tube.
CAUTION:
z
z
z
z
Be careful not to turn the connection part of the nylon tube and the quick connector when
connecting them.
Do not kink the nylon tube.
Do not remove the EPDM protector on the outside of the nylon tube.
Do not close the piping with the nylon tube by bending it.
4. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAK
(a) Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance to the fuel system
.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM0000028SB001X
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028SA001X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Hose and pipe connection is as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
The filler hose must be replaced with a new one.
2. INSTALL FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Push in the tube connector to the pipe until the
connector makes a "click" sound and install the retainer.
NOTICE:
z
z
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the
connected part of the pipe.
After connecting, check if the pipe and the connector are
securely connected by pulling them.
3. INSTALL FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE TUBE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket onto the fuel tank.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Set the fuel suction tube assembly to the fuel tank.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the fuel sender gage.
(c) Fit a spline of the fuel suction tube assembly into a keyway of the fuel tank.
(d) Install a retainer.
(1) Using a new retainer, align mark on the retainer with
a screw-threads starting point of the fuel tank.
(2) While holding the fuel suction tube assembly, tighten
the retainer one complete turn by hand.
(e) Using a SST, tighten the retainer one more complete
turn, and position the mark on the retainer into a range
A of the fuel tank.
SST: 09808-14020
09808-01410
09808-01420
09808-01430
HINT:
z
z
Turn the retainer two complete turns and position the
mark within the range A for the installation of the
retainer.
A rib on the retainer can be fitted into a tip of the SST.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
4. INSTALL FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK RETURN TUBE
(a) Connect the fuel tank main tube with the tube joint clip.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
Check that there is no scratch or foreign objects on the
connecting parts.
Check that the connector is fully inserted.
Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar of the
connector.
After installing the tube joint clip, check if the tubes are
securely connected by puling then.
5. INSTALL FUEL TANK CUSHION
(a) Install 3 new fuel tank cushions to the fuel tank.
6. INSTALL FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Set a mission jack to the fuel tank.
(b) Install the fuel tank and 2 fuel tank bands with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
7. CONNECT FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Push in the tube connector to the pipe until the
connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
z
z
Check that there is no damage or foreign objects on the
connected part of the pipe.
After connecting, check if the pipe and the connector are
securely connected by pulling them.
8. CONNECT FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK RETURN TUBE
(a) Push in the tube connector to the pipe until the
connector makes a "click" sound.
NOTICE:
z
z
Check that there is no damage or foreign objects on the
connected part of the pipe.
After connecting, check if the pipe and the connector are
securely connected by pulling them.
9. INSTALL NO. 1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Set a mission jack to the fuel tank protector.
(b) Install the fuel tank protector with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 20 N·m (204 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
10. CONNECT FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Hose and pipe connection is as shown in the illustration.
11. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE
12. INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Connect the connector.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Install the 3 screws and rear floor service hole cover.
(c) Install the rear floor carpet assembly.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Fuel System
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000028SC001X
Title: 1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
HINT:
2. REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Hold the rear No. 1 seat assembly LH.
(b) Hold the rear No. 1 seat assembly RH.
(c) Remove a tear-off floor mat.
(d) Remove the 3 screws from the rear floor service hole cover.
(e) Disconnect the connector.
3. REMOVE FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Disconnect the fuel-tank-to-filler-pipe hose from the fuel
filler pipe.
4. DRAIN FUEL
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
5. REMOVE NO. 1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Set a mission jack to the fuel tank protector.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and the fuel tank protector.
6. DISCONNECT FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK RETURN TUBE
(a) Pinch the tabs of the retainer to remove the lock claws
and pull out the 2 fuel tank tubes.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
z
Check that there is no dirt or mud around the quick
connector before this work, because the quick connector
has an O-ring which seals the pipe and the connector.
Clean the connector if necessary.
Do not use any tool in this work.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube.
To protect the tube, cover it with a vinyl bag after
checking.
When connector and the pipe are stuck, turn the retainer
carefully to free and then disconnect the fuel tank tube.
7. DISCONNECT FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Pinch a tab of the retainer to remove the lock claws and
pull out the fuel tank tube.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
z
Check that there is no dirt or mud around the quick
connector before this work, because the quick connector
has an O-ring which seals the pipe and the connector.
Clean the connector if necessary.
Do not use any tool in this work.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube by force.
To protect the tube, cover it with a vinyl bag after
checking.
When connector and the pipe are stuck, turn the retainer
carefully to free and then disconnect the tube.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
8. DISCONNECT FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank breather tube from the fuel tank.
(1) Push the connector deep inside.
(2) Pinch portion A, as shown in the illustration.
(3) Pull out the connector.
9. REMOVE FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Set a mission jack to the fuel tank.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 fuel tank bands and fuel tank.
10. REMOVE FUEL TANK CUSHION
11. REMOVE FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE AND FUEL TANK RETURN TUBE
(a) Remove the 2 tubes joint clips, and pull out the 2 fuel
tank tubes.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
z
Check that there is no dirt or mud around the quick
connector before this work, because the quick connector
has an O-ring which seals the pipe and the connector.
Clean the connector if necessary.
Do not use any tool in this work.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube by force.
After disconnecting, cover the fuel tube joint with a vinyl
bag.
When the fuel tube joint and fuel suction plate are stuck,
turn the fuel tank main tube carefully to free and then
disconnect it. Likewise, disconnect the fuel tank return
tube.
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
12. REMOVE FUEL SUCTION WITH PUMP & GAGE TUBE ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
Protect a connector and tube joint with a masking tape or something in order to prevent sticking
foreign objects onto them, and clean dirt and foreign objects from the fuel suction tube
assembly before removing it.
(a) Using a SST, loosen the retainer.
SST: 09808-14020
09808-01410
09808-01420
09808-01430
HINT:
A rib on the retainer can be fitted into a tip of the SST.
(b) Remove the retainer.
(c) Pull out the fuel suction tube assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the sender gage.
(d) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
13. REMOVE FUEL TANK BREATHER TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Pinch the tab of the retainer to remove the lock claws
and pull out the fuel tank breather tube.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
z
z
Check that there is no dirt or mud around the quick
connector before this work, because the quick connector
has an O-ring which seals the pipe and the connector.
Clean the connector if necessary.
Do not use any tool in this work.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube.
To protect the tube, cover it with a vinyl bag after
checking.
When connector and the pipe are stuck, turn the fuel
tank breather tube carefully to free and then disconnect
1GR-FE FUEL: FUEL TANK: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
the tube.
14. REMOVE FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
(a) Remove the fuel tank inlet hose from the fuel tank.
1GR-FE IGNITION: IGNITION SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B4N002X
Title: 1GR-FE IGNITION: IGNITION SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" mean the temperature of the coils themselves. "Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to
50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100 °C (212°F).
1GR-FE IGNITION: IGNITION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Engine Control
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000000SM6018X
Title: 1GR-FE IGNITION: IGNITION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
"Cold" and "Hot" in this section mean the temperature of the coils themselves. "Cold" is from 10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. CHECK IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY AND PERFORM SPARK TEST
(a) Check for DTCs.
NOTICE:
If any DTC is present, perform troubleshooting in accordance with a procedure for that DTC.
(b) Check that sparks occur.
(1) Remove the ignition coils.
(2) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, remove the spark plugs.
(3) Install the spark plugs to each ignition coil, and connect the ignition coil connectors.
(4) Disconnect the 6 injector connectors.
(5) Ground the spark plugs.
(6) Check if sparks occur at each spark plug while the engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
z
z
z
Be sure to ground the spark plug when checking.
Replace the ignition coil if it receives an impact.
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
If sparks do not occur, perform the following test:
(c) Spark test flow chart.
(1) Check that the wire harness side connector of ignition coil assembly is securely connector.
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Connect securely.
OK
Go to next step.
(2) Perform spark test on each ignition coil assembly.
z
z
Replace ignition coil assembly with a normal one.
Perform spark test again.
1GR-FE IGNITION: IGNITION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Replace ignition coil assembly.
OK
Go to next step.
(3) Check power supply to ignition coil.
z
z
Turn ignition switch ON.
Check that there is battery positive (+) voltage at ignition coil positive (+) terminal.
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Check wiring between ignition switch and ignition coil assembly.
OK
Go to next step.
(4) Check resistance in VVT sensor out put voltage (see step 2).
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Following test 1.
OK
Go to next step.
z
Check that the wiring between VVT sensor and ECM.
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Repair wiring between VVT sensor and ECM.
OK
Repair VVT sensor
(5) Check resistance in crankshaft position sensor.
Standard resistance:
STANDARD CONDITION
SPECIFIED CONDITION
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Replace the crankshaft position sensor.
OK
Go to next step.
1GR-FE IGNITION: IGNITION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(6) Check IGT signal from ECM.
Result:
RESULT
PROCEED TO
NG
Check ECM
OK
Repair wiring between ignition coil and ECM.
(d) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, install the spark plugs.
Torque: 20 N·m (204 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(e) Install the ignition coils.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
2. CHECK VVT SENSOR OUTPUT VOLTAGE
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the voltage between terminal VC1 and ground is 5 V.
HINT:
For the terminal arrangement of the engine ECU
.
(c) While turning the crankshaft pulley by hand, measure the voltage between each terminal. Check
that the voltage changes between the Hi range and Lo range shown in the table below.
Standard voltage:
SENSOR POSITION
TERMINAL NO.
VOLTAGE (HI)
VOLTAGE (LO)
Bank 1
VV1+ ←→ VV1-
3.375 to 4.950
0.450 to 1.375
Bank 2
VV2+ ←→ VV2-
3.375 to 4.950
0.450 to 1.375
HINT:
For the terminal arrangement of the engine ECU
.
1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Intake/Exhaust
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029RW001X
Title: 1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
(a) Inspect the diaphragm.
(1) Check that the lever moves when vacuum of 26.6
kPa (200 mmHg) is applied with the mighty bag on.
(2) Check that the vacuum of 26.6 kPa (200 mmHg) is
sustained for 1 minute in the above state.
2. INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING NO. 1 VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the VSV for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between each terminals.
Resistance:
33 to 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(b) Inspect the VSV for ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between each terminal and the body.
(c) Inspect the VSV operation.
1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(1) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runn...
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Intake/Exhaust
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029RX002X
Title: 1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL FUNCTION
(a) Remove the V-bank cover.
(b) Set intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST, then check that the actuator rod operates.
(d) Start the engine.
(e) Check that the VSV for ACIS is ON under the condition (procedure [A]).
z
z
Depressing the accelerator pedal to 60 % accelerator opening angle.
Racing the engine above 4,700 rpm.
(f) Check that the VSV for ACIS is OFF under the condition.
z
z
The engine idling.
Release the accelerator pedal when the condition of procedure [A].
2. INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runn...
(a) Remove V-bank cover.
(b) Using a 3-way connector, connect vacuum gauge to the actuator hose.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) While the engine is idling, check that the vacuum gauge needle momentarily fluctuates up to
approximately 39.9 kPa (300 mmHg, 11.8 in.Hg). (The actuator rod is pulled out.)
(e) Rapidly depress the accelerator pedal to fully open position and check that the vacuum gauge
needle points to 0 kPa (0 mmHg, 0 in.Hg). (The actuator rod is returned.)
(f) Remove the vacuum gauge, and connect the vacuum hose to the actuator.
(g) Reinstall V-bank cover.
1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 R
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Intake/Exhaust
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000029RV002X
Title: 1GR-FE INTAKE: INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
PARTS LOCATION
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002B8L002X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000172N003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the oil cooler for damage and clogging.
If necessary, replace the oil cooler.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000172M003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the oil cooler contact surface on the cooler mounting.
(b) Install a new O-ring onto the oil cooler.
(c) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the union bolt.
(d) Install the oil cooler and plate washer with the union
bolt.
Torque: 68 N·m (693 kgf·cm, 50 ft·lbf)
(e) Connect the 2 oil cooler hoses to the oil cooler.
2. INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
3. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
4. ADD ENGINE OIL
5. INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEVEL
6. INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEAKS
7. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
8. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM00000172O003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: ENGINE OIL COOLER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2. REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
3. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
4. REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 oil cooler hoses from the oil cooler.
(b) Remove the union bolt, plate washer and oil cooler.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the oil cooler.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: LUBRICATION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017MF008X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: LUBRICATION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
(a) Check the oil for deterioration, water contamination, discoloring or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil and filter.
2. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
(a) Warm up the engine, then stop the engine and wait for 5 minutes.
(b) Check that the engine oil level is between the low level and full level marks on the level gauge.
If low, check for leakage and top oil up to the full level mark.
NOTICE:
Do not fill with engine oil to above the full level mark.
3. INSPECT OIL PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector.
(b) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, remove the oil pressure switch.
(c) Install the oil pressure gauge.
(d) Warm up the engine.
(e) Inspect the oil pressure.
Oil pressure:
WHEN IDLING
29 KPA (0.3 KGF*CM 2, 4.2 PSI) OR MORE
At 3,000 rpm
294 to 588 kPa (3.0 to 6.0kgf*cm 2, 43 to 85 psi)
(f) Remove the oil pressure gauge.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: LUBRICATION SYSTEM: ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(g) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure
switch.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond 1344 or
Equivalent
(h) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, install the oil pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N·m (153 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine within 1 hour of installation.
(i) Connect the oil pressure switch connector.
(j) Start the engine and check for engine oil leakage.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002B8K002X
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017LZ003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter
bracket.
(b) Lubricate the rubber gasket of a new oil filter with clean engine oil.
(c) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket comes into contact with the seat of the filter
bracket.
(d) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn to set the
filter.
SST: 09228-07501
Torque: 18 N·m (184 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
2. ADD ENGINE OIL
(a) Fill with fresh engine oil.
Standard engine oil:
OIL GRADE
ILSAC multigrade engine oil
OIL VISCOSITY (SAE)
- 5W-30
Standard capacity:
ITEM
SPECIFIED CONDITION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Drain and refill with oil filter change
5.2 liters (5.5 US qts, 4.6 Imp. qts)
Drain and refill without oil filter change
4.9 liters (5.2 US qts, 4.3 Imp. qts)
Dry fill
6.0 liters (6.3 US qts, 5.3 Imp. qts)
(b) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
3. INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEAKS
4. INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEVEL
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017M0003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
z
z
z
z
Prolonged and repeated contact with engine oil will cause the removal of natural oils from the skin,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
Precautions should be taken when replacing engine oil to minimize the risk of your skin making
contact with used engine oil.
Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use waterless hand cleaner to remove any used
engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
For environmental protection, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at designated
disposal sites.
1. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the engine under cover seal No. 3.
(b) Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the engine oil.
(c) Clean the oil pan drain plug and install it with a new gasket.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
2. REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the drain pipe cap.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL FILTER: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(b) While removing the oil filter with SST, catch the oil from the oil filter with a container.
SST: 09228-07501
(c) Install the drain pipe cap.
(d) Clean the oil catch plate.
HINT:
When using a drain hose, perform the following procedures.
(e) Remove the drain pipe cap.
(f) Connect a drain hose to the oil filter bracket.
HINT:
z
z
Drain hose inside diameter: 8 mm (0.31 in.)
Drain hose length: 900 mm (35.43 in.)
(g) Feed the drain hose down through the engine under cover, and put the drain oil container beneath
the drain hose to catch the oil from the oil filter.
(h) Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST: 09228-07501
(i) Remove the drain hose and install the drain pipe cap.
(j) Clean the oil catch plate.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
Doc ID: RM000002B8J002X
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017M5003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE OIL PUMP COVER
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil pipe.
(b) Remove the 2 O-rings.
(c) Remove the 7 bolts, oil pump cover, drive rotor and
driven rotor.
2. REMOVE OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Remove the plug, spring and relief valve.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017M2003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Coat the valve with engine oil, then check that it falls smoothly into the valve hole by its own
weight.
If not, replace the relief valve. If necessary, replace the oil pump assembly.
2. INSPECT OIL PUMP ROTOR SET
(a) Place the drive and driven rotors into the timing chain cover with the marks facing upward.
(b) Check the rotor tip clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard clearance:
0.06 to 0.16 mm (0.0024 to 0.0063 in.)
Maximum tip clearance: 0.16 mm (0.0063 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the drive and driven rotors together.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(c) Check the rotor side clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge and precision straight edge,
measure the clearance between the rotors and
precision straight edge.
Standard clearance:
0.03 to 0.09 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum side clearance: 0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the drive and driven rotors. If necessary,
replace the timing chain cover assembly.
(d) Check the rotor body clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the driven rotor and body.
Standard clearance:
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
Maximum body clearance: 0.325 mm (0.0128 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the drive and driven rotors. If necessary,
replace the timing chain cover assembly.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017M1003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL TIMING CHAIN COVER OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST and hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the timing chain cover edge.
SST: 09226-10010
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
2. INSTALL TIMING CHAIN COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material. Be careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of
the timing chain cover, cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Install a new O-ring onto the LH cylinder head as shown
in the illustration.
(c) Apply continuous beads of seal packing (diameter 3 to 4
mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) to the 4 locations as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(d) Apply continuous beads of seal packing (diameter 3 to 4
mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) to the timing chain cover as
shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Water pump part
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B
or Equivalent
Other parts
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or
Equivalent
NOTICE:
z
z
Install the timing chain cover within 3 minutes of
applying the seal packing. Timing chain cover bolts and
nuts must be tightened within 15 minutes of installation.
Otherwise, the seal packing must be removed and
reapplied.
Do not apply seal packing to portion A shown in the
illustration.
(e) Align the key way of the oil pump drive rotor with the
rectangular portion of the crankshaft timing gear, and
slide the timing chain cover into place.
(f) Install the timing chain cover with the 24 bolts and 2
nuts. Tighten the bolts and nuts uniformly in several
steps.
Torque: 23 N·m (235 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Pay attention not to wrap the chain and slipper over
the timing chain cover seal line.
Each bolt length is as follows:
BOLT
LENGTH
A
25 mm (0.98 in.)
B
55 mm (2.17 in.)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
3. INSTALL OIL FILTER BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil filter bracket with the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 19 N·m (194 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
4. INSTALL VVT SENSOR
5. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the camshaft timing oil control valves to each cylinder head, and tighten the 2 bolts.
6. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
7. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
8. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
9. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
10. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
11. INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL NO.2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
13. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
14. INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
15. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
16. INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
17. INSTALL COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
18. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
19. REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
20. INSTALL WATER INLET
21. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
22. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
23. CONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
24. INSTALL FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
25. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
26. FULLY TIGHTEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
27. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
28. INSTALL BATTERY
29. INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY FRONT
30. INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
31. ADD ENGINE OIL
32. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
33. INSPECT ENGINE OIL LEAKS
34. INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT LEAK
35. INSTALL V-BANK COVER
(a) Install the V-bank cover with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000017M6003X
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
REASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Coat the relief valve with engine oil and insert the relief valve and spring into the valve hole.
(b) Install the relief valve plug.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
2. INSTALL OIL PUMP COVER
(a) Apply fresh engine oil to the drive and driven rotors.
(b) Place the drive and driven rotors into the timing chain cover with the marks facing the oil pump
cover side.
(c) Install the oil pump cover with the 7 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
(d) Install a new O-ring onto the oil pump cover.
(e) Install a new O-ring onto the oil pipe.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(f) Install the oil pipe with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in·lbf)
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Lubrication
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Title: 1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSEMBLY
2. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSEMBLY FRONT
3. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
4. DRAIN ENGINE OIL
5. REMOVE BATTERY
6. REMOVE V-BANK COVER
7. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SEAL UPPER
(a) Remove the 11 clips and radiator support seal upper.
8. LOOSEN FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
9. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
10. REMOVE FAN WITH FLUID COUPLING
11. DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
12. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
13. REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAUGE GUIDE
(a) Remove the oil level gauge.
(b) Remove the bolt and pull out the oil level gauge guide.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the oil level gauge guide.
14. REMOVE WATER INLET
15. SEPARATE VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY
16. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Doc ID: RM0000017M4003X
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
17. SEPARATE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
18. REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
19. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 idler pulleys.
20. REMOVE NO.1 IDLER PULLEY SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
21. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
22. REMOVE NO.2 OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
23. REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSEMBLY
24. REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSEMBLY
25. REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
26. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
27. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
28. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
29. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 oil control valve connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 camshaft timing oil control valves.
30. REMOVE VVT SENSOR
31. REMOVE OIL FILTER BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts, oil filter bracket and gasket.
32. REMOVE TIMING CHAIN COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 24 bolts and 2 nuts.
1GR-FE LUBRICATION: OIL PUMP: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
(b) Remove the timing chain cover by prying between the
timing chain cover and cylinder head or cylinder block
with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the
timing chain cover, cylinder block and cylinder head.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the LH cylinder head.
33. REMOVE TIMING CHAIN COVER OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil pump assembly. Wrap
the tip of the screwdriver with tape.
1GR-FE STARTING: ACC CUT RELAY: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DZ6004X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: ACC CUT RELAY: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT ACC CUT RELAY
(a) Continuity inspection.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between
each terminal.
Specified condition:
BETWEEN TERMINALS
SPECIFIED CONDITION
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 3 and 5 when voltage is applied
across terminals 1 and 2.
Specified condition:
Continuity
1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DYR003X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DYQ003X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the switch continuity.
Standard:
TERMINAL NO.
SWITCH
POSITION
SPECIFIED
CONDITION
Between all
terminals
LOCK
No continuity
2-3
ACC
Continuity
ON
Continuity
START
Continuity
2-3-4
6-7
1-2-4
6-7-8
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch assembly.
1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DYP003X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the ignition switch with the 2 screws.
(b) Install the clamp.
(c) Connect the un-lock warning switch connector and ignition switch connector.
2. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER
(a) Install the steering column upper cover.
3. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER
1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DYS003X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: IGNITION SWITCH: REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER
2. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER
(a) Remove the steering column upper cover.
3. REMOVE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the ignition switch connector and un-lock
warning switch connector.
(b) Remove the clamp.
(c) Remove the 2 screws and ignition switch.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEM002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEO002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut, and disconnect the lead wire from the
C terminal.
(b) Remove the 2 through bolts.
(c) Pull out the starter yoke and the armature together.
(d) Remove the O-ring from the starter yoke.
2. REMOVE MAGNET STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and magnet starter switch.
(b) Remove the these parts from the starter drive housing.
(1) Starter magnet switch return spring (Procedure "A").
(2) Starter idle gear pinion (Procedure "B").
(3) Starter idle gear clutch roller (Procedure "C").
(4) Starter idle gear retainer (Procedure "D").
(5) Starter clutch sub-assembly (Procedure "E").
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(c) Using a magnetic finger, remove the steel ball from the
clutch shaft hole.
3. REMOVE STARTER BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and end cover from the starter
yoke.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the starter yoke.
(c) Using a screwdriver, hold the spring back and disconnect
the 4 brushes from the brush holder.
(d) Remove the brush holder from the armature.
4. REMOVE STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the starter armature assembly.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEL002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT STARTER ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 3 to 5 seconds to avoid burning out the coil.
(a) Do pull-in test (Condition A).
(1) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal C.
(2) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as
shown. Check that the clutch pinion gear protrudes.
(b) Do holding test.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the terminal C
with the above condition A is being sustained.
Check that the pinion gear remains protruded.
(c) Inspect clutch pinion gear return.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the switch
body. Check that the clutch pinion gear returns
inward.
(d) Perform the operation test without load.
(1) Connect the field coil lead wire to terminal C.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 89 ft·lbf)
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in·lbf)
(2) Hold the starter with a vise.
(3) Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter as
shown.
(4) Check that the ammeter indicates the specified
current.
Specified current (for standard area):
90 A or less at 11.5V
Specified current (for cold area)
100 A or less at 11.5 V
2. INSPECT STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the commutator for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the segments of the commutator.
If there is no continuity between any segment,
replace the armature.
(b) Check the commutator for ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the commutator and armature coil core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature.
(c) Check the commutator for dirty and burn on surface.
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper (No. 400) or a lathe.
(d) Check for the commutator runout.
(1) Place the commutator on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial gauge, measure the runout.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
If the runout is greater than maximum, correct it on
a lathe.
(e) Using vernier calipers, measure the commutator
diameter.
Standard diameter:
35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
Maximum diameter
34.0 mm (1.339 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the
armature.
(f) Check that the undercut depth is clean and free of
foreign objects. Smooth out the edge.
Standard undercut depth:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Minimum undercut depth
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
If the undercut depth is less than minimum, correct it
with a hacksaw blade.
3. INSPECT STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the starter yoke for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the lead wire and brushes.
If there is no continuity, replace the starter yoke.
(b) Check the shunt coil for open circuit.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
shunt coil terminals (A) and (B).
Standard resistance:
1.5 to 1.9 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
starter yoke.
4. INSPECT BRUSH
(a) Check the brushes length.
(1) Using vernier calipers, measure the brush length.
Standard length:
15.0 mm (0.591 in.)
Minimum length
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
If the length is less than minimum, replace the brush
holder and starter yoke.
5. INSPECT STARTER BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the brush holder insulation.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the positive (+) and negative (-) brush
holders.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the brush
holder.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
(b) Check the brush spring load.
(1) Take a pull scale reading at the instant the brush
spring separates from the brush.
Standard spring load:
21.5 to 27.5 N (2.2 to 2.8 kgf, 4.8 to 6.2 lbf)
Minimum spring load
12.7 N (1.3 kgf, 2.9 lbf)
If the spring load is less than the minimum, replace
the brush holder.
6. INSPECT STARTER CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the clutch pinion gear.
(1) Hold the starter clutch and rotate the pinion gear
clockwise, and check that it turns freely.
(2) Try to rotate the pinion gear counterclockwise and
check that it locks.
If necessary, replace the starter clutch.
7. INSPECT MAGNET STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the pull-in coil for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminal 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnet starter
switch.
(b) Check the holding coil for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminal 50 and the switch body.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnet starter
switch.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEG005X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Install the starter assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N·m (377 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the wire harness to the terminal 30 and install the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the terminal 50 to the starter assembly.
2. CONNECT WIRE HARNESS (for 2WD)
(a) Connect the wire harness to the cylinder block and install the bolt.
Torque: 13 N·m (133 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
3. INSTALL NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY (for 2WD)
(a) Install the No. 2 manifold stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
4. INSTALL ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Install the engine rear under cover assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
5. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 2WD)
(a) Connect the battery negative terminal.
6. INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Install the starter assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N·m (377 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the wire harness to the terminal 30 and install the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the terminal 50 to the starter assembly.
7. INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the steering sliding yoke to No. 2 steering
intermediate shaft.
(b) Install the bolt B and tighten the bolt B and A.
Torque: 36 N·m (367 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
8. INSTALL FRONT FENDER REAR SPLASH SHIELD LH (for 4WD)
(a) Install the front fender rear splash shield LH with the 5 clips.
9. INSTALL NO. 2 FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Install 2 new gaskets and No. 2 exhaust manifold with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 2) connector.
10. INSTALL ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Install the engine rear under cover assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
11. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 4WD)
(a) Connect the battery negative terminal.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEP002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
REASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply the grease to the bearings, and install it to the starter yoke.
2. INSTALL STARTER BRUSH HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the brush holder on the armature.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the 4 brushes.
(c) Install a new O-ring to the groove of the field frame.
(d) Install the end frame with 2 screws.
Torque: 3.8 N·m (39 kgf·cm, 34 in·lbf)
3. INSTALL MAGNET STARTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply grease to the steel ball, and install it to the clutch shaft hole.
(b) Apply grease to the these parts "B" to "E", and install
them to the starter drive housing.
(1) Starter magnet switch return spring (Procedure "A").
(2) Starter idle gear pinion (Procedure "B".
(3) Starter idle gear clutch roller (Procedure "C").
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(4) Starter idle gear retainer (Procedure "D").
(5) Starter clutch sub-assembly (Procedure "E").
(c) Install the magnet starter switch with the 2screws.
4. INSTALL STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the groove of the starter yoke.
(b) Align the key of the starter yoke with the groove of the
magnet starter switch.
(c) Install the starter yoke and armature with the 2 through
bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N·m (95 kgf·cm, 82 in·lbf)
(d) Connect the lead wire to the C terminal with the nut.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in·lbf)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000026Q1005X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 2WD)
(a) Disconnect the negative battery terminal.
2. REMOVE ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine rear under cover assembly.
3. REMOVE NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY (for 2WD)
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and No. 2 manifold stay.
4. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS (for 2WD)
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the wire harness from the cylinder block.
5. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Disconnect the terminal 50 connector from the starter assembly.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the wire harness from the terminal 30.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and starter assembly.
6. DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 4WD)
(a) Disconnect the negative battery terminal.
7. REMOVE ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine rear under cover assembly.
8. REMOVE NO. 2 FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 2) connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, No. 2 front exhaust pipe assembly and 2 gaskets.
9. REMOVE FRONT FENDER REAR SPLASH SHIELD LH (for 4WD)
(a) Remove the 5 clips and front fender rear splash shield
LH.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Cold Area): REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
10. SEPARATE NO. 2 STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Loosen the bolt A and remove the bolt B, then separate
the No. 2 steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly.
11. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Disconnect the terminal 50 connector from the starter assembly.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the wire harness from the terminal 30.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and starter assembly.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER RELAY: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DOM001X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER RELAY: INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT STARTER RELAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Continuity inspection.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between
each terminal
Specified condition:
BETWEEN TERMINALS
SPECIFIED CONDITION
1-2
Continuity
3-5
No continuity
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 3 and 5 when voltage is applied
across terminals 1 and 2.
Specified condition:
Continuity
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 K
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DZS002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
COMPONENTS
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): COMPONENTS (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEI002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE REPAIR SERVICE STARTER KIT
(a) Remove the nut, and disconnect the lead wire from the
repair service starter kit.
(b) Remove the 2 screws which are used to secure the
repair service starter drive housing.
(c) Remove the repair service starter kit.
(d) Remove the return spring and plunger.
2. REMOVE STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 through bolts, and pull out the starter
yoke assembly together with the commutator end frame
assembly.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
3. REMOVE STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the commutator end frame assembly from the starter yoke assembly.
4. REMOVE STARTER ARMATURE PLATE
(a) Remove the starter armature plate from the starter yoke assembly.
5. REMOVE STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME COVER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the cover.
6. REMOVE STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring and plate
washer.
(b) Remove the starter armature assembly from commutator end frame assembly.
7. REMOVE PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Remove the 3 planetary gears.
8. REMOVE STARTER CENTER BEARING CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the starter center bearing clutch and drive lever
set pin together from the starter drive housing.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): DISASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Remove the drive lever set pin from the starter center bearing clutch.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 G
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEH002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
INSPECTION
1. INSPECT STARTER ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 3 to 5 seconds to avoid burning out the coil.
(a) Do pull-in test (Condition A).
(1) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal C.
(2) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as
shown. Check that the clutch pinion gear protrudes.
(b) Do holding test.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the terminal C
with the above condition A is being sustained.
Check that the pinion gear remains protruded.
(c) Inspect clutch pinion gear return.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the switch
body. Check that the clutch pinion gear returns
inward.
(d) Perform the operation test without load.
(1) Connect the field coil lead wire to terminal C.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 89 ft·lbf)
(2) Hold the starter with a vise.
(3) Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter as
shown.
(4) Check that the ammeter indicates the specified
current.
Specified current:
90 A or less at 11.5V
2. INSPECT STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the commutator for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between the segments of the commutator.
If there is no continuity between any segments,
replace the armature.
(b) Check the commutator for ground.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the commutator and armature coil core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature.
(c) Check the commutator for dirty and burn on surface.
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper (No. 400) or a lathe.
(d) Using vernier calipers, measure the commutator length.
Standard length:
3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
Maximum length
3.8 mm (0.150 in.)
If the length is greater than maximum, replace the
armature.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
3. INSPECT STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the brash holder length.
Standard length:
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Minimum length
4.0 mm (0.158 in.)
If the length is less than minimum, replace the starter
commutator end frame assembly.
(b) Check the brush holder.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity
between the positive (+) and negative (-) brush
holders.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the starter
commutator end frame assembly.
4. INSPECT STARTER CENTER BEARING CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the gear teeth of the planetary gear, and the starter center bearing clutch for wear or
damage.
If any one of the planetary gear is damaged, replace the planetary gear assembly.
If any one of the gears of the starter center bearing clutch is damaged, replace the clutch.
(b) Check the clutch pinion gear.
(1) Rotate the clutch pinion gear clockwise and check
that it turns freely.
(2) Try to rotate the clutch pinion gear counterclockwise
and check that it locks
If necessary, replace the center bearing clutch subassembly.
5. INSPECT REPAIR SERVICE STARTER KIT
(a) Check the plunger.
(1) Plush in the plunger and check that it returns quickly
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSPECTION (2007 4Runner)
to its original position.
If necessary, replace the repair service starter kit.
(b) Check the pull-in coil for open circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, replace the repair service
starter kit.
(c) Check whether or not the hold-in coil has an open
circuit.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminal 50 and the switch body.
If there is no continuity, replace the repair service
starter kit.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEG004X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Install the starter assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N·m (377 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the wire harness to the terminal 30 and install the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the terminal 50 to the starter assembly.
2. CONNECT WIRE HARNESS (for 2WD)
(a) Connect the wire harness to the cylinder block and install the bolt.
Torque: 13 N·m (133 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
3. INSTALL NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY (for 2WD)
(a) Install the No. 2 manifold stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 40 N·m (408 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
4. INSTALL ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Install the engine rear under cover assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
5. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 2WD)
(a) Connect the battery negative terminal.
6. INSTALL STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Install the starter assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N·m (377 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the wire harness to the terminal 30 and install the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the terminal 50 to the starter assembly.
7. INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): INSTALLATION (2007 4Runner)
(a) Install the steering sliding yoke to No. 2 steering
intermediate shaft.
(b) Install the bolt B and tighten the bolt B and A.
Torque: 36 N·m (370 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
8. INSTALL FRONT FENDER REAR SPLASH SHIELD LH (for 4WD)
(a) Install the front fender rear splash shield LH with the 5 clips.
9. INSTALL NO. 2 FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Install 2 new gaskets and No. 2 exhaust manifold with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 2) connector.
10. INSTALL ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Install the engine rear under cover assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
11. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 4WD)
(a) Connect the battery negative terminal.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEJ002X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
REASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL STARTER CENTER BEARING CLUTCH SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the drive lever set pin to the starter center
bearing clutch.
(b) Install the starter center bearing clutch and drive lever set pin together to the starter drive
housing.
2. INSTALL PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Apply grease to the planetary gears and pin parts of the
planetary shaft.
(b) Install the 3 planetary gears.
3. INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply grease to the plate washer and armature shaft.
(b) Install the armature shaft to the starter commutator end frame assembly.
(c) Using snap ring pliers, install the plate washer and new
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
snap ring.
(d) Using vernier calipers, measure the snap ring.
Maximum length:
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
If the length is greater than maximum, replace the new
snap ring.
4. INSTALL STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME COVER
(a) Install the starter commutator end frame cover.
5. INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE PLATE
(a) Insert the starter armature plate to the starter yoke assembly.
(b) Align the keyway of the plate with the key inside the
starter yoke, and install the plate.
6. INSTALL STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the starter-commutator-rubber -end frame with
the convex cutout of starter yoke.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(b) Install starter-commutator-end -frame to starter yoke assembly.
7. INSTALL STARTER YOKE ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the key of the starter yoke assembly with the
keyway of starter drive housing.
(b) Install the starter yoke assembly with the 2 through
bolts.
Torque: 6.0 N·m (61 kgf·cm, 53 in·lbf)
8. INSTALL REPAIR SERVICE STARTER KIT
(a) Apply grease to the plunger and hook.
(b) Hang the plunger hook of the repair service starter kit to
the drive lever.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REASSEMBLY (2007 4Runner)
(c) Install the plunger and return spring.
(d) Install the repair service starter kit with the 2 screws.
Torque: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in·lbf)
(e) Connect the lead wire to the terminal with the nut.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7.4 ft·lbf)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 A
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM0000026Q1004X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 2WD)
(a) Disconnect the battery negative terminal.
2. REMOVE ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine rear under cover assembly.
3. REMOVE NO. 2 MANIFOLD STAY (for 2WD)
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and No. 2 manifold stay.
4. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS (for 2WD)
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the wire harness from the cylinder block.
5. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 2WD)
(a) Disconnect the terminal 50 connector from the starter assembly.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the wire harness from the terminal 30.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and starter assembly.
6. DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (for 4WD)
(a) Disconnect the battery negative terminal.
7. REMOVE ENGINE REAR UNDER COVER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine rear under cover assembly.
8. REMOVE NO. 2 FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 2) connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, No. 2 front exhaust pipe assembly and 2 gaskets.
9. REMOVE FRONT FENDER REAR SPLASH SHIELD LH (for 4WD)
(a) Remove the 5 clips and front fender rear splash shield
LH.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTER (for Standard): REMOVAL (2007 4Runner)
10. SEPARATE NO. 2 STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Loosen the bolt A and remove the bolt B, then separate
the No. 2 steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly.
11. REMOVE STARTER ASSEMBLY (for 4WD)
(a) Disconnect the terminal 50 connector from the starter assembly.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the wire harness from the terminal 30.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and starter assembly.
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
Last Modified: 4-26-2007
1.6 R
Service Category: Engine/Hybrid System
Section: Starting
Model Year: 2007
Model: 4Runner
Doc ID: RM000002DEQ001X
Title: 1GR-FE STARTING: STARTING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
PARTS LOCATION
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
ILLUSTRATION
1GR-FE STARTING: STARTING SYSTEM: PARTS LOCATION (2007 4Runner)
4RUNNER – MAJOR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
1
MAJOR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Area
Item
U.S.A.
U.S.A. and Canada
Body Type
5-door Wagon
Vehicle Grade
Model Code
Overall
Length
mm (in.)
Width
Height*1
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Wheel Base
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Shoulder Room
Front
Rear
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Length
mm (in.)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
Width
Height
Front
Rear
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
Min. Running Ground Clearance
mm (in.)
225 (8.9)
30
24*5, 26*6
1015 (2240), 1007 (2220)*7
225 (8.9)
30
24*5, 26*6
1020 (2250), 1012 (2230)*7
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
1110 (2445), 1102 (2425)*7
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
1115 (2460), 1107 (2440)*7
915 (2015), 936 (2060)*7
1930 (4255), 1943 (4280)*7
1131 (2495)
1375 (3020)
920 (2030), 941 (2075)*7
1940 (4280), 1953 (4305)*7
1131 (2495)
1375 (3020)
935 (2060), 956 (2105)*7
2045 (4505), 2058 (4530)*7
1229 (2710)
1494 (3295)
940 (2070), 961 (2115)*7
2055 (4530), 2068 (4555)*7
1229 (2710)
1494 (3295)
2490 (5490)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
2490 (5490)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
2723 (6005)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
2723 (6005)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
54 (33)
93 (58)
136 (84)
54 (33)
93 (58)
136 (84)
21 (13)*8, 54 (33)*9
36 (22)*8, 93 (58)*9
53 (33)*8, 136 (84)*9
21 (13)*8, 54 (33)*9
36 (22)*8, 93 (58)*9
53 (33)*8, 136 (84)*9
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194/ 5400 (260 @ 5400)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194/ 5400 (260 @ 5400)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194/ 5400 (260 @ 5400)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194/ 5400 (260 @ 5400)
415/ 3400 (306 @ 3400)
12 − 55, 12 − 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
415/ 3400 (306 @ 3400)
12 − 55, 12 − 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
415/ 3400 (306 @ 3400)
12 − 55, 12 − 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
415/ 3400 (306 @ 3400)
12 − 55, 12 − 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
A750E
3.520
2.042
A750E
3.520
2.042
A750F
3.520
2.042
A750F
3.520
2.042
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
/ 3.727
/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
/ 3.727
/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
1.000/ 2.566
3.727/ 3.727
203 (8)/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
1.000/ 2.566
3.727/ 3.727
203 (8)/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Cargo Space
Overhang
Angle of Approach
degrees
Max. Cruising Speed
Performance
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
Front
Rear
degrees
Front
kg (lb)
Curb Weight
Rear
kg (lb)
Total
kg (lb)
Front
kg (lb)
Gross Vehicle Weight
Rear
kg (lb)
Total
kg (lb)
Fuel Tank Capacity
(US.gal, Imp.gal)
Luggage Compartment Capacity
m3 (cu.ft.)
Max. Speed
km / h (mph)
Max. Permissible
Speed
Turning Diameter
(Outside Front)
1st Gear
2nd Gear
3rd Gear
4th Gear
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
5th Gear km / h (mph)
Wall to Wall m (ft.)
Curb to Curb m (ft.)
Engine Type
Valve Mechanism
Engine
Limited (4WD)
UZN215L-GKAZKA
4805 (189.2)
Effective Leg Room
Angle of Departure
Engine
Electrical
SR5 (4WD)
UZN215L-GKAGKA
4805 (189.2)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Effective Head Room
Bore × Stroke
Displacement
mm (in.)
cm3 (cu.in.)
Compression Ratio
Fuel System
Octane Rating
Max. Output (SAE-NET) kW / rpm (HP@rpm)
Max. Torque (SAE-NET) N.m / rpm (ft-lb@rpm)
Battery Capacity (5HR)
Voltage & Amp. hr.
Generator Output
Starter Output
Watts
kW
Clutch Type
Transmission Type
Gear Ratio
In First
In Second
In Third
In Fourth
In Fifth
In Reverse
Transfer Gear Ratio H4 / L4
Differential Gear Ratio (Front / Rear)
Chassis
Limited (2WD)
UZN210L-GKAZKA
4805 (189.2)
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Tread
Major Dimensions & Vehicle Weights
mm (in.)
SR5 (2WD)
UZN210L-GKAGKA
4805 (189.2)
Differential Gear Size (Front / Rear)
Front
Brake Type
Rear
Parking Brake Type
Brake Booster Type and Size
Proportioning Valve Type
Suspension Type
Stabilizer Bar
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Steering Gear Type
Steering Gear Ratio (Overall)
Power Steering Type
*1: Unladen Vehicle
*2: With Roof Rail + 45 mm (1.77 in.)
With Rear Spoiler + 40 mm (1.57 in.)
mm (in.)
in.
*3: With Sliding Roof
*4: Min/ Max
*5: With Hitch Receiver
*6: Without Hitch Receiver
*7: With 3rd Seat
*8: Transfer in Low
5
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
55
60
65
70
75
4RUNNER – MAJOR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
2
U.S.A.
U.S.A. and Canada
5-door Wagon
5
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
SR5 (2WD)
GRN210L-GKAGKA
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
Limited (2WD)
GRN210L-GKAZKA
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
SR5 (4WD)
GRN215L-GKAGKA
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
Limited (4WD)
GRN215L-GKAZKA
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
225 (8.9)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
225 (8.9)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
230 (9.1)
935 (36.8)/ 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
952 (2100), 944 (2080)*7
882 (1945), 903 (1990)*7
30
24*5, 26*6
957 (2110), 949 (2090)*7
887 (1955), 908 (2000)*7
30
24*5, 26*6
1047 (2310), 1039 (2290)*7
902 (1990), 923 (2035)*7
30
24*5, 26*6
1052 (2320), 1044 (2300)*7
907 (2000), 928 (2045)*7
1834 (4045), 1847 (4070)*7
1059 (2335)
1365 (3010)
2417 (5330)
1844 (4065), 1857 (4090)*7
1059 (2335)
1365 (3010)
2417 (5330)
1949 (4300), 1962 (4325)*7
1156 (2550)
1388 (3060)
2531 (5580)
1959 (4320), 1972 (4345)*7
1156 (2550)
1388 (3060)
2531 (5580)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
87 (23, 19.1)
180 (112)
58 (36)
100 (62)
146 (90)
58 (36)
100 (62)
146 (90)
22 (14)*8, 58 (36)*9
39 (24)*8, 100 (62)*9
57 (35)*8, 146 (90)*9
21 (13)*8, 54 (33)*9
36 (22)*8, 93 (58)*9
53 (33)*8, 136 (84)*9
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
1GR-FE
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
1GR-FE
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
1GR-FE
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
1GR-FE
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
10 : 1
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
10 : 1
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
10 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
176/ 5200 (236 @ 5200)
361/ 4000 (266 @ 4000)
SFI
87 or higher
176/ 5200 (236 @ 5200)
361/ 4000 (266 @ 4000)
SFI
87 or higher
176/ 5200 (236 @ 5200)
361/ 4000 (266 @ 4000)
SFI
87 or higher
176/ 5200 (236 @ 5200)
361/ 4000 (266 @ 4000)
12-55, 12-64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
12-55, 12-64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
12-55, 12-64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
12-55, 12-64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
A750E
3.520
2.042
1.400
A750E
3.520
2.042
1.400
A750F
3.520
2.042
1.400
A750F
3.520
2.042
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
/ 3.727
1.000
0.716
3.224
/ 3.727
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.000/ 2.566
3.727/ 3.727
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.000/ 2.566
3.727/ 3.727
/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
203 (8)/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
203 (8)/ 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Hydraulic
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Hydraulic
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Hydraulic
Double Wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Hydraulic Type
Hydraulic Type
Hydraulic Type
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
45
10 : 1
50
55
60
65
70
75
*9: Transfer in High
*10: Option
3
– MEMO –
6
APPENDIX
MAJOR TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Area
Item
U.S.A.
5-door Wagon
Body Type
Vehicle Grade
Model Code
Major Dimensions & Vehicle Weights
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
Effective Leg Room
Front
Rear
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Shoulder Room
Front
Rear
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
Length
mm (in.)
Width
Height
Front
Rear
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
Min. Running Ground Clearance
mm (in.)
1095 (43.1)
225 (8.9)
30
24*5, 26*6
1095 (43.1)
225 (8.9)
30
24*5, 26*6
1095 (43.1)
225 (8.9)
30
24*5, 26*6
1095 (43.1)
225 (8.9)
30
24*5, 26*6
952 (2100), 944 (2080)*7
882 (1945), 903 (1990)*7
1834 (4045), 1847 (4070)*7
1059 (2335)
957 (2110), 949 (2090)*7
887 (1955), 908 (2000)*7
1844 (4065), 1857 (4090)*7
1059 (2335)
1015 (2240), 1007 (2220)*7
915 (2015), 936 (2060)*7
1930 (4255), 1943 (4280)*7
1131 (2495)
1020 (2250), 1012 (2230)*7
920 (2030), 941 (2075)*7
1940 (4280), 1953 (4305)*7
1131 (2495)
1365 (3010)
2417 (5330)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
1365 (3010)
2417 (5330)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
1375 (3020)
2490 (5490)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
1375 (3020)
2490 (5490)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
180 (112)
—
58 (36)
100 (62)
180 (112)
—
58 (36)
100 (62)
180 (112)
—
54 (33)
93 (58)
180 (112)
—
54 (33)
93 (58)
146 (90)
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
146 (90)
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
136 (84)
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
136 (84)
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
1GR-FE
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
1GR-FE
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
176 / 5200 (236 / 5200)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
176 / 5200 (236 / 5200)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194 / 5400 (260 / 5400)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194 / 5400 (260 / 5400)
361 / 4000 (266 / 4000)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
361 / 4000 (266 / 4000)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
415 / 3400 (306 / 3400)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
415 / 3400 (306 / 3400)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
Effective Head Room
mm (in.)
Width
Height
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Cargo Space
Overhang
Angle of Approach
degrees
Angle of Departure
degrees
Front
kg (lb)
Curb Weight
Rear
kg (lb)
Total
kg (lb)
Front
kg (lb)
Gross Vehicle Weight
Rear
kg (lb)
Total
kg (lb)
Fuel Tank Capacity
(US.gal, Imp.gal)
Luggage Compartment Capacity
m3 (cu.ft.)
Max. Speed
km / h (mph)
Max. Cruising Speed
Performance
Limited
UZN210L-GKAZKA
mm (in.)
Tread
Max. Permissible
Speed
Turning Diameter
(Outside Front)
1st Gear
2nd Gear
3rd Gear
4th Gear
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
km / h (mph)
5th Gear km / h (mph)
Wall to Wall m (ft.)
Curb to Curb m (ft.)
Engine Type
Valve Mechanism
Engine
SR5
UZN210L-GKAGKA
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Length
Wheel Base
Engine
Electrical
Limited
GRN210L-GKAZKA
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
Overall
Bore × Stroke
Displacement
mm (in.)
cm3 (cu.in.)
Compression Ratio
Fuel System
Octane Rating
Max. Output (SAE-NET)
kW / rpm (HP / rpm)
Max. Torque (SAE-NET)
N.m / rpm (ft- lb/ rpm)
Battery Capacity (5HR)
Voltage & Amp. hr.
Generator Output
Starter Output
Watts
kW
Clutch Type
Transmission Type
Gear Ratio
In First
In Second
In Third
In Fourth
In Fifth
In Reverse
Transfer Gear Ratio H4 / L4
Differential Gear Ratio (Front / Rear)
Chassis
SR5
GRN210L-GKAGKA
Differential Gear Size (Front / Rear)
Front
Brake Type
Rear
Parking Brake Type
Brake Booster Type and Size
Proportioning Valve Type
Suspension Type
Stabilizer Bar
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Steering Gear Type
Steering Gear Ratio (Overall)
Power Steering Type
*1: Unladen Vehicle
*2: With Roof Rail + 45 mm (1.77 in.)
With Rear Spoiler + 40 mm (1.57 in.)
mm (in.)
in.
—
A750E
3.520
2.042
—
A750E
3.520
2.042
—
A750E
3.520
2.042
—
A750E
3.520
2.042
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
—
— / 3.727
— / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
—
— / 3.727
— / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
—
— / 3.727
— / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
—
— / 3.727
— / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
*3: With Sliding Roof
*4: Min / Max
*5: With Hitch Receiver
*6: Without Hitch Receiver
*7: With 3rd Seat
*8: Transfer in Low
5
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
55
60
65
70
75
7
APPENDIX
U.S.A. and Canada
5-door Wagon
5
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
SR5
GRN215L-GKAGKA
Limited
GRN215L-GKAZKA
SR5
UZN215L-GKAGKA
Limited
UZN215L-GKAZKA
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
4805 (189.2)
1910 (75.2)
1760 (69.3)*2
2790 (109.8)
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1575 (62.0)
1575 (62.0)
1009 (39.7), 972 (38.3)*3
992 (39.1), 970 (38.2)*3
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1061 (41.8)
879 (34.6)
1473 (58.0)
1454 (57.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1105 (43.5)
1051 (41.4)
935 (36.8) / 969 (38.1)*4
920 (36.2)
1095 (43.1)
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
1095 (43.1)
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
1095 (43.1)
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
1095 (43.1)
230 (9.1)
30
24*5, 26*6
1047 (2310), 1039 (2290)*7
902 (1990), 923 (2035)*7
1949 (4300), 1962 (4325)*7
1156 (2550)
1052 (2320), 1044 (2300)*7
907 (2000), 928 (2045)*7
1959 (4320), 1972 (4345)*7
1156 (2550)
1110 (2445), 1102 (2425)*7
935 (2060), 956 (2105)*7
2045 (4505), 2058 (4530)*7
1229 (2710)
1115 (2460), 1107 (2440)*7
940 (2070), 961 (2115)*7
2055 (4530), 2068 (4555)*7
1229 (2710)
1388 (3060)
2531 (5580)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
1388 (3060)
2531 (5580)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
1494 (3295)
2723 (6005)
87 (23, 19,1)
—
1494 (3295)
2723 (6005)
87 (23, 19.1)
—
180 (112)
—
22 (14)*8, 58 (36)*9
39 (24)*8, 100 (62)*9
180 (112)
—
21 (13)*8, 54 (33)*9
36 (22)*8, 93 (58)*9
180 (112)
—
21 (13)*8, 54 (33)*9
36 (22)*8, 93 (58)*9
180 (112)
—
21 (13)*8, 54 (33)*9
36 (22)*8, 93 (58)*9
57 (35)*8, 146 (90)*9
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
53 (33)*8, 136 (84)*9
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
53 (33)*8, 136 (84)*9
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
53 (33)*8, 136 (84)*9
—
—
12.3 (40.4)
11.7 (38.4)
1GR-FE
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
2UZ-FE
32-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 84.0 (3.70 × 3.31)
4664 (284.5)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
176 / 5200 (236 / 5200)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194 / 5400 (260 / 5400)
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
194 / 5400 (260 / 5400)
361 / 4000 (266 / 4000)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
415 / 3400 (306 / 3400)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
415 / 3400 (306 / 3400)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.4, 2.0*10
1GR-FE
24-valve, DOHC with VVT-i
94.0 × 95.0 (3.70 × 3.74)
3956 (241.4)
45
10.0 : 1
SFI
87 or higher
176 / 5200 (236 / 5200)
50
55
60
65
70
75
361 / 4000 (266 / 4000)
12 - 55, 12 - 64*10
1560
1.6, 2.0*10
—
A750F
3.520
2.042
—
A750F
3.520
2.042
—
A750F
3.520
2.042
—
A750F
3.520
2.042
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.400
1.000
0.716
3.224
1.000 / 2.566
3.727 / 3.727
203 (8) / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
1.000 / 2.566
3.727 / 3.727
203 (8) / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
1.000 / 2.566
3.727 / 3.727
203 (8) / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
1.000 / 2.566
3.727 / 3.727
203 (8) / 203 (8)
Ventilated Disc
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Ventilated Disc
Duo-servo Drum
Hydraulic
—
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Double-wishbone
4-link with Lateral Rod
Standard
Standard
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
Rack and Pinion
15.7
Hydraulic Type
*9: Transfer in High
*10: Option
AP
8
– MEMO –
4
INTRODUCTION – MODEL CODE & MODEL LINE-UP
MODEL CODE
GRN210 L – G K A G K A
1
2
BASIC MODEL CODE
1
2
CODE
DRIVE TYPE
GRN210
GRN215
UZN210
UZN215
2WD
4WD
2WD
4WD
ENGINE
TYPE
3
4
5
6
7
8
5
GEAR SHIFT TYPE
A: 5-speed Automatic, Floor
6
GRADE
G: SR5
Z: Limited
7
ENGINE SPECIFICATION
K: DOHC and SFI
8
DESTINATION
A: U.S.A. and Canada
1GR-FE
2UZ-FE
STEERING WHEEL POSITION
L: Left-hand Drive
3
MODEL NAME
G: Wagon
4
BODY TYPE
K: 5-door
MODEL LINE-UP
TRANSMISSION
DESTIDESTI
NATION
DRIVE
TYPE
ENGINE
1GR FE
1GR-FE
USA
U.S.A.
2WD
2UZ FE
2UZ-FE
U.S.A.
SA
and
Canada
1GR FE
1GR-FE
4WD
2UZ FE
2UZ-FE
GRADE
5-speed Automatic
A750E
A750F
SR5
GRN210L-GKAGKA
—
Limited
GRN210L-GKAZKA
—
SR5
UZN210L-GKAGKA
—
Limited
UZN210L-GKAZKA
—
SR5
—
GRN215L-GKAGKA
Limited
—
GRN215L-GKAZKA
SR5
—
UZN215L-GKAGKA
Limited
—
UZN215L-GKAZKA
4RUNNER – OUTLINE OF NEW FEATURES
1
4RUNNER
OUTLINE OF NEW FEATURES
The following changes are made for the 2008 model year.
1. Exterior
The design of the front bumper grille has been changed.
A
A
07EMO01Y
Front Bumper Grille
’08 4Runner
’07 4Runner
A - A Cross Section
2. Brake Control System
The VSC OFF switch is used on all models. For details, see page 5.
An Auto LSD function is added to the brake control system for the 1GR-FE engine 4WD models.
3. Tire Pressure Warning System
In the tire pressure warning system, the following items have been changed.
Changed Item
’08 4Runner
’07 4Runner
Time required for the tire pressure warning ECU
to determine a malfunction in the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter
20 minutes
51 minutes
Detection of vehicle speed (Judgment of vehicle
running)
Vehicle speed signal
(combination meter) and
engine speed signal (ECM)
Vehicle speed signal
(combination meter)
The illumination pattern of the tire pressure
warning light when the system fails
Turns ON after
blinking for 1 minute
Blinks
The blinking of the tire pressure warning light
between the registration of the ID code of the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter and the
normal operation of the system
Turns ON after
blinking for 1 minute
—
4RUNNER – OUTLINE OF NEW FEATURES
2
The following DTCs (Diagnostic Trouble Codes) are added.
DTC
Detection Item
C2126/ 26
Transmitter ID not Received in Main Mode
C2173/ 73
Vehicle Speed or Engine Speed Signal Malfunction
C2194/ 94
Engine Speed Signal Error (Test Mode DTC)
4. Seat Belt Warning System
The specifications of the seat belt warning system have been changed. For details, see page 9.
4RUNNER – NEW FEATURES
5
NEW FEATURES
BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
1. General
The VSC OFF switch is used. The operation of the VSC and TRAC functions can be stopped by the VSC
OFF switch. While the vehicle is running off the shoulder of the road or running on the dirt road, the engine
output control is stopped to maintain drive torque.
2. System Diagram
Hydraulic Brake Booster
Pump Motor
Relay
Speed Sensor (4)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Pump Motor
Switching
Solenoid Valve
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
Solenoid Relay
Switch*1
Control
Solenoid Valve
Parking Brake Switch
Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor
Downhill Assist Control
4WD Control Switch*1
Skid Control
ECU
Accumulator Pressure Sensor
Center Diff. Lock Switch*1
Combination Meter
VSC OFF Switch
ABS Warning Light
Brake System Warning Light
Slip Indicator Light
VSC OFF Light
Auto LSD Indicator Light*2
Downhill Assist Control
Indicator Light*1
Speedometer
Stop Light Switch
Stop Light
Control Relay
DLC3
Suspension
Control ECU*3
ECM
VSC Warning
Buzzer
Steering Angle Sensor
Yaw Rate & Deceleration Sensor
CAN (V Bus)
07ECH001Y
*1: Only for 4WD Models *2: 1GR-FE Engine Models and 2UZ-FE Engine 2WD Models
*3: Only for Models with Rear Air Suspension
4RUNNER – NEW FEATURES
6
3. Layout of Main Components
Brake System Warning Light
Slip Indicator Light
VSC OFF Light
ABS Warning Light
Auto LSD
Indicator Light*2
Downhill Assist Control
Indicator Light*1
Steering Angle
Sensor
Combination Meter
ECM
VSC Warning Buzzer
Stop Light Switch
DLC3
VSC OFF Switch
Yaw Rate &
Deceleration Sensor
Downhill Assist
Control Switch
Speed Sensors
Hydraulic Brake Booster
(with Actuator and Skid Control ECU)
Speed Sensors
*1: Only for 4WD Models *2: 1GR-FE Engine Models and 2UZ-FE Engine 2WD Models
07ECH002Y
4RUNNER – NEW FEATURES
7
4. VSC OFF Switch
The VSC OFF switch can select the 3 modes [Normal mode, TRAC-OFF mode (Auto LSD control
mode*1), VSC-OFF mode].
On the 2WD models, the Auto LSD function operates when the TRAC-OFF mode is selected.
On the 1GR-FE engine 4WD models, the Auto LSD function operates when the 4WD control switch is
at the “H2” position and the TRAC-OFF mode is selected.
Normal
Mode
TRAC-OFF Mode
(Auto LSD
Control Mode*1)
VSC-OFF
Mode
04FCH153I
: Switch Operation (Press shortly.)
: Switch Operation
(Keep pressing for 3 seconds with the vehicle at a standstill.)
After the ignition switch is turned OFF in the TRAC-OFF mode (Auto LSD control mode*1) or VSC-OFF
mode, turning the ignition switch ON again selects the Normal mode.
The operations of the brake control functions and the illumination state of the respective indicator lights
in each mode are as follows:
: Controllable ×: Not Controllable
Brake Control Function
Item
TRAC
Normal Mode
TRAC-OFF Mode
(Auto LSD Control
Mode*)
VSC-OFF Mode
Auto
LSD*1
Auto LSD
Indicator Light
Slip
Indicator Light
03NCH004Y
03NCH005Y
VSC OFF
Light
VSC
03NCH006Y
×
—
—
—
×
Light ON
Light ON
—
×
×
×
—
Light ON
Light ON
*: 1GR-FE Engine Models and 2UZ-FE Engine 2WD Models
NOTE
The TRAC and VSC functions control brake hydraulic pressure and engine output to ensure vehicle
stability.
Therefore, operate the VSC OFF switch (stop the operation of the TRAC and VSC functions) only
when it is necessary.
4RUNNER – NEW FEATURES
8
5. Warning, Indicator Lights and VSC Warning Buzzer
The warning, indicator and VSC OFF lights and VSC warning buzzer operate as follows:
: Illuminates (Continuous Sound) : Blinks (Intermittent Sound)
Warning Light
Indicator Light
Condition
03NCH012Y
03NCH007Y
Initial Check
During
p
Operation
Driving
Mode
03NCH008Y
VSC
Downhill Assist
Control
Hill-start Assist
Control
TRAC-OFF Mode
(Auto LSD Control
Mode*1)
VSC-OFF Mode
03NCH010Y 07ECH003Y
EBD
*1
*1
H4L, L4L
*2
ABS & Brake Assist
TRAC/ A-TRAC,
Auto LSD
VSC
Downhill Assist
Control
Hill-start Assist
Control
Low Brake Fluid
Level
ABS Malfunction
Others
TRAC/ A-TRAC
During Actuator Protection
Cannot
Operate
Due to a
Malfunction
03NCH009Y
Zero Point Calibration
of Yaw Rate &
Deceleration Sensor
not Done
Low Accumulator
Pressure
Warning
Buzzer
*2
*2
*1: Lights up when the Auto LSD and/ or downhill assist control are operational.
*2: Blinks when the downhill assist control switch is pushed.
4RUNNER – NEW FEATURES
9
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
1. General
If a seat belt is not fastened, this system flashes the seat belt warning light or sounds the buzzer in the
combination meter as a reminder.
When the ignition switch is turned ON, this system detects the condition of the seat belts based on the
signals from the driver and front passenger seat belt buckle switches and the occupant classification sensor.
2. Warning Method
The timing chart of the buzzer and details of the warning method are shown below.
Timing Chart
Ignition Switch
ON
*
OFF
12 mph (20km/h)
or more
Vehicle Speed
0 mph
Not Fasten
Driver Seat Belt
Buckle Switch
Fasten
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Buckle
Switch
Not Fasten
Shift Position
(Reverse)
Fasten
Hi
Lo
LVL2
Buzzer
LVL1
OFF
T4
T5
T4
T7
T8
T4 T7
T1
T2
T6
T3
T5
T3
Flash (0.4 sec.)
Driver Seat Belt
Warning Light Flash (1.2 sec.)
OFF
Flash (0.4 sec.)
Front Passenger
Flash (1.2 sec.)
Seat Belt
Warning Light
OFF
0140BE193C
T1: About 1.8 sec.
T2: About 1.2 sec. × 5
T3: About 13.8 sec.
T4: About 9.6 sec.
T5: About 20 sec.
T6: About 20 sec. or more
T7: About 20 sec. or less
T8: About 9.6 sec. or less
*: If the vehicle speed drops below the setting level for seat belt warning after a buzzer begins to sound, the
buzzer will continue to sound. After the vehicle speed exceeds 20km/ h (12 mph) again, the buzzer will
stop.
2
INTRODUCTION – OUTLINE OF NEW FEATURES
INTRODUCTION
OUTLINE OF NEW FEATURES
1. Model Line-up
The Urban Runner package which has been developed based on the Sport package is newly provided for the
GRN210L-GKAGKA and GRN215L-GKAGKA models for U.S.A.
2. Exterior
Exclusive emblems are provided for the Urban Runner package.
4WD model: “URBAN RUNNER 4WD” for the front door, and “X-REAS” for the back door.
2WD Model: “URBAN RUNNER” for the front door, and “X-REAS” for the back door.
A radiator grille which is painted with the same color as an exterior color is provided for the Urban Runner
package, as well as for the Limited grade.
A smoke lens type headlight which is the same as for the Sport package is provided for the Urban Runner
package.
An exclusive rear spoiler is provided for the Urban Runner package.
07EMO01Y
07EMO02Y
Urban Runner Package
Other
A silver roof rail is optional equipment for the Urban Runner package.
18-inch aluminum disc wheels which are the same as for the Limited grade are provided for the Urban
Runner package.
The following three exterior colors are provided for the Urban Runner package:
Color No.
Color Name
Note
070
White Pearl Crystal Shine
Carryover
1D4
Silver Metallic
Carryover
202
Black
Carryover
INTRODUCTION – OUTLINE OF NEW FEATURES
3
3. Interior
An instrument panel center cluster, a front console and a door trim, which are used for the Limited grade,
are provided for the Urban Runner package.
A plated inside door handle is provided for the Urban Runner package.
A rear console lid with leather upholstery is provided for the Urban Runner package.
A seat with Alcantala and leather upholstery is provided for the Urban Runner package.
A steering wheel using dimple leather is provided for the Urban Runner package.
: Dimple Leather
07EMO03Y
IN
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
(BAT)
(BAT)
(IG)
40A
ABS MTR
10A
IGN
30A
ABS SOL
2
23 1E
: 2UZ–FE
: 1GR–FE 4WD
: w/ Electric Modulated Air Suspension
: w/o Electric Modulated Air Suspension
1
J4
Junction
Connector
G
R
L
P
B–O
L–O
9
Y
FRO
Y–B
FLO
8
Y–B
C
2 A
2 B
31 A
18 A
4 A
3 A
17 A
1 B
38 A
+BM1
FL+
+BS
+BM2
FL–
FR+
FR–
IG2
S15
Suspension
Control ECU
C
2
(∗3)
2
1
2
3
4
L–R
1
∗
∗
∗
∗
B–O
Y–B
A10
ABS Speed Sensor
Front RH
2
A9
ABS Speed Sensor
Front LH
2
(∗3)
2
37 A
FLO
FRO
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
RL–
RR–
19 A
W
PKB
GND3
LBL
41 A
4 B
28 A
GND1
1 A
W–B
A B
A A
A A
6 BC2
3 BC2
4 BE1
3 BE1
2
B
W
(∗4)
W–B
(∗4)
B
W–B
A41
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear RH
A40
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear LH
W
1
2
P4
Parking Brake SW
1 BE1
W–B
LG
W–B
1
2 BE1
1
1
W–B
EA
EB
BO
-1-
(∗1)
LG
A B
2
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction Connector
B B
W–B
W
B
(∗4)
(Shielded)
V
(∗3)
G
(∗4)
P
(∗3)
(∗4)
R
(∗4)
(Shielded)
B A
W–B
J 2(A), J 3(B)
Junction
Connector
1 1E
W–B
2 BC2
W–B
1 BC2
2 1E
B14
Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
5 BC2
(∗1)
8 IB2
W–B
V
4 BC2
7 IB2
W
10 IB2
B
9 IB2
P
W–B
LG
5 A
B
RR+
6 A
V
RL+
20 A
P
GND2
32 A
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
(BAT)
G–W
(IG)
Y–R
8 1J
4
2
J1
Junction
Connector
A
20 1E
Y–R
E A
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
C A
B
G–B
B
STP2
LG
7 A
16 A
STP
Y–R
A
A
P
2
G–B
G–B
G–Y
45 A
8 IM1
6
13 IC2
J4
Junction
Connector
H A
Y–R
G–B
J4
Junction
Connector
G–Y
G–Y
C A
E
E
H A
C
1
B
C
J25
Junction
Connector
G–B
P1
Park/Neutral
Position SW
LG
G–B
E
A
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
2
2
S12
Stop Light
SW
E
J35
Junction
Connector
2
A
G–B
G–W
G–W
3
E
J 8(A)
Junction
Connector
2
2
1
STOP LP CTRL
Relay
5
D
J7
Junction
Connector
D
2
15A
IG1
2
Y–R
2
G–B
10A
STOP
Y–R
Y–R
2 IM1
Y–R
14 A
STPO
P
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
CSW
R–W
W–G
(4WD)
43 A
R–W
W–G
(4WD)
(4WD)
3
D5
Downhill Assist
Control SW
9
V15
VSC Off SW
11 IM2
IND2
B 3F
B 3F
A B
W–B
R–L
B 3F
W–B
J28
Junction
Connector
W–B
B
A B
J14(A), J15(B)
Junction
Connector
W–B
W–B
R–L
(4WD)
(4WD)
A A
B 3F
B
B
20 A
4
W–B
G B
(4WD)
R–L
J31(A), J32(B)
Junction
Connector
G–R
(4WD)
F A
G–R
3
CDL
4
(4WD)
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction
Connector
W–L
(4WD)
L4
6 IC2
W–B
22 B
W–B
P1
F 9(A), F10(B)
4WD Control ECU
A
J37
Junction
Connector
ADD
24 A
17 IC2
J24
Junction
Connector
18 B
H B
W–L
J28
Junction
Connector
C
GR
F A
(4WD)
GR
C
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
C
T3
Transfer Shift
Actuator
(4WD)
GR
(∗2)
GR
(∗2)
E A
16 IM2
R–L
J20(A), J21(B)
Junction
Connector
G–R
(4WD)
A B
18 IC3
(∗2)
HDCS
44 A
1 IC2
12 IC2
(4WD)
W–L
2 IC2
3
6 EC1
R–L
G–R
(4WD)
W–L
GR
A11
ADD Actuator
ADD
EXI
27 A
(∗2)
W–B
(∗1)
NEO
10 A
(4WD)
EXI4
21 A
(4WD)
EXI3
26 A
II
-2-
A
A
A
IK
W–B
J5
Junction
Connector
A
IG
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
B–R
(IG)
R–Y
R–B
10A
ECU–IG
R–Y
R–B
15 IC2
4 IC2
R–Y
R–B
B
D
28 1J
B–R
12 1E
R–W
B–R
J4
Junction
Connector
B–R
V5
VSC Warning
Buzzer
2
B
R–W
F
J4
Junction
Connector
F
J1
Junction
Connector
F
5 IC2
D
R–W
46 A
BZ
R–B
B–R
30 A
R–Y
GR–G
1
13 A
24 A
42 A
IG1
D/G
TS
WFSE
S28(A), S29(B)
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
CANH
SP1
BRL
WA
IND
VSCW
INFR
HDCW
33 A
V–W
BR–Y
20 IC2
7 IC3
V–W
9 IC2
Y–R
19 IC2
R
18 IC2
LG–R
8 IC2
B–L
7 IC2
GR–R
11 IC2
B
22 IC2
W
Y–R
15 A
R
36 A
LG–R
34 A
B–L
29 A
GR–R
3 B
B
12 A
W
11 A
(4WD)
CANL
25 A
BR–Y(4WD)
V–W
Y–R
R
LG–R
B–L
GR–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B
W
-3-
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
B–R
B–R
R–Y
R–Y
R–B
R–B
R–W
R–W
∗ 1 : 2UZ–FE
∗ 8 : 1GR–FE
(IG)
(BAT)
7. 5A
GAUGE
10A
DOME
2
4 1G
C 8(A), C 9(B), C10(C), C11(D)
Combination Meter
R
R–L
2
15 C
Slip
17 C
20 C
J7
Junction
Connector
D
13 C
16 C
F B
J29(A), J30(B)
Junction Connector
BR
4 B
GR–R
LG–R
19 A
B–L
R
Y–R
V–W
BR–Y(4WD)
H A
4 D
B A
BR–Y(4WD)
D B
R
BR
V–W
J 8(A), J 9(B)
Junction
Connector
R
VSC OFF
18 C
D
BRAKE
AUTO LSD
12 A
ABS
Downhill Assist Control
Speedometer
R
10 IC4
Y–R
7 IM1
BR
(∗1)
BR
LG–R
(∗8)
R
B–L
GR–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
B
B
W
W
EE
-4-
ED
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
B–R
R–Y
R–Y
R–B
R–B
R–W
R–W
R
W
(BAT)
10A
ECU–B
2
W–R
B–R
2
G A
4 1B
J20(A)
Junction
Connector
G A
D A
B 3E
E B
D A
J12(A), J13(B)
Junction
Connector
W–R
B–R
4 1L
GND
CANL
11
3
1
2
CANL
W
CANH
ESS
2
R
B–R
IG
W–B
B–R
5
IG1
B
1
BAT
Y
W–R
9
W–B
S11
Steering Sensor
B 3E
3
CANH
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
B
Y
W–B
W–B
B
B
W
W
-5-
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
R–Y
R–B
R–W
R
R–Y
W
G A
J18(A)
Junction
Connector
R–W
R–B
R–Y
G A
15
12
7
D1
Data Link
Connector 3
WFSE
TS
CANH
SIL
V
L
LG
CANL
34
P
CANH
33
R
CANL
14
W
6
E7
Engine Control Module
1 B
2 B
1 D
2 D
1 E
2 E
2 C
1 A
2 A
Y
B
W
J47(A), J48(B), J49(C),
J50(D), J51(E), J52(F)
Junction
Connector
1 F
W–B
1 C
B
ST–Plug
B
Y
B
W
IH
-6-
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
A9
A 10
A 11
A 40
A 41
Gray
Gray
Black
Black
Black
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
2
B 14
C8
C9
Gray
White
White
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
1
2
C 10
C 11
D1
White
White
White
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
2
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
1
D5
E7
F9
Blue
White
White
2
3
4
1
7
2
8
3
4
5
6
1
28 29 30
7
7
8
8
J1
J2
Blue
6
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
5
6
3
2
1
21 22 23 24
White
5
4
6
F 10
4
5
4
White
3
6
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20
31 32 33 34 35
1
2
5
3
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
1
2
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
7
9 10 11
1
2
3
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
7
8
9 10 11 12
4
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
J3
J4
J5
J7
Blue
Black
White
Blue
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
3
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
-7-
4
5
2
1 2 3
6
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
4 5
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
1
2
3
4
5
J8
J9
J 12
Blue
Blue
Black
6
7
8
9 10 11
1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
1
2
3
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
7
8
9 10 11 12
4
5
J 13
J 14
J 15
J 18
Black
Gray
Gray
Blue
1
2
3
6
1
2
3
6
1
2
3
7
8
9 10 11 12
7
8
9 10 11 12
7
8
9 10 11 12
4
5
4
5
4
5
1
6
2
3
2
3
4
5
J 20
J 21
J 24
Blue
Blue
White
6
7
8
9 10 11
1
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
2
J 25
J 28
J 29
White
Blue
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
1
2
3
4
J 30
J 31
J 32
Black
Black
7
8
5
6
9 10 11
1
2
3
6
1
2
3
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
7
8
9 10 11 12
7
8
9 10 11 12
4
2
3
4
5
8
9 10 11
4
5
6
5
7
8
9 10 11
4
5
6
J 35
J 37
J 47
J 48
J 49
Blue
White
White
White
White
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
1
7
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
Blue
6
6
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
1
5
2
3
Blue
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
4
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
1
1
6
6
7
8
9 10 11
3
2
4
5
6
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
J 50
J 51
J 52
P1
P4
White
White
White
Gray
Black
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
5
6
-8-
2
7
3
8
4
9
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
S 11
S 12
S 15
White
Blue
White
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
3
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1
4
10
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
1
2
31
32
27 28 29 30
S 28
S 29
Black
Black
1
2
3
4
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
T3
V5
V 15
Y1
Black
Black
Blue
Black
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
1
1
2
2
3
6
1
1E
1G
White
4 5
3
4
5
6
1
7
17 18 19 20 21 22
1
5
White
2
3
4
5
6
7
13 14 15 16 17 18
11 12 13
4
1B
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
2
3
White
1 2 3
1
2
4
5
8
9 10 11 12
19 20
21 22 23 24
1
1J
1L
White
White
9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
1
23 24 25 26
8
27 28 29 30 31 32
13 14 15 16 17 18
3E
3F
Dark Gray
White
6
7
14 15 16 17 18 19
8
9 10
20 21 22
1
2
3
10 11 12
4
5
2
6
3
7
13 14 15 16 17 18
-9-
4
5
8
6
9
19 20
7
2
3
2
3
4
4
8
9 10 11 12
19 20
21 22 23 24
5
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
BC2
BE1
White
White
11 10 9
9 10 11
2
3
4
5
6
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
3
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
1
8
EC1
IB2
Gray
White
3 2 1
1 2
6 5 4
5 6
2
4
2
4
1
3
3 4
7
8
9 10 11
5
4
4 3
2 1
11 10 9
8
7
6 5
8
7
6
IC2
Gray
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
11 10 9
9 10 11
8
7
6
3
2
1
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
IC3
Blue
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
IC4
White
Gray
Gray
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
19
10 11
20 21
12 13
22 23
14 15
24 25
16 17
26 27
29
37
18 30 31 32
33 34 35
4
3
2
1
9
21 20
11 10
23 22
13 12
25 24
15 14
27 26
38 39 40 28
36
5
19
37
29
28 40 39 38
41 42 43
43 42 41
- 10 -
17 16
32 31 30 18
36
35 34 33
ABS , Auto LSD , Downhill Assist Control , Hill-Start Assist Control , TRAC , VSC
IM1
White
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
5 4
3 2 1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6
IM2
White
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
- 11 -
2003-
4RUNNER TVIP V5 RS3200 PLUS
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM (EWD)
2003-
4RUNNER
TVIP V5
RS3200 PLUS
CONNECTORS
G
F
E
1
2
21
5
10 11 12
25
29
1
4 5 6
3
8
(TERMINAL PIN)
31
(FEMALE PIN)
(FEMALE PIN)
P
M
2
1
2 1
4 3
S
1
6 7
T
4 5
9 10 11 12 13
5 4
1
13 12 11 10 9
(MALE PIN)
(MALE PIN)
(F E MALE P IN)
(MALE P IN)
7 6
2005-
4RUNNER
TVIP V2 GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR (GBS)
ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM (EWD)
ACC
IG1
AM1
ST1
ST2
AM2
DRIVER SIDE J/B
IG2
IG-CONTROL
15A
CENTER J/B
A7
A2
R
G6
M1
M2
B
GBS ECU
G1
W-B
BATTERY
W
MICROPHONE
G5
W-R
M'1
Y-R
M'2
W-B
G4
A1
R
G8
ALT 140A
DOME 10A
AM2 36A
AM1 50A
IGNITION SW
G3
R
W-B
B1
Y-R
B7
Y
B2
HEATER CONTROL SW
11
SECURITY ECU
Splice
Splicing to vehicle W/H
TVIP W/H
VEHICLE
W/H
TVIP W/H
VEHICLE W/H
Plug in connector
2005-
4RUNNER
TVIP V2 GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR (GBS)
CONNECTORS
4RUNNER V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
A
4
B
7
5
3
2
1
14
12 11 10 9
8
1
8
2
3
4
G
5
9 10 11 12
7
14
1
4 5 6
M
3
8
2
1
(F E MALE P IN)
(MALE P IN)
(F E MALE P IN)
(MALE P IN)
V E HIC LE S IDE C ONNE C T OR
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
(F E MALE P IN)
TOYOTA-SIRIUS CUSTOMER TROUBLESH OOTING FLOWCHART
Turn ignition on (ACC).
Verify AM/FM operates
normally
INCLUDING
NO
NOTE
The following tests should be
accomplished with the vehicle parked
outside in clear view of the sky.
Volume
Balance (left & right aud io)
Channel presets
Seek/Tune
YES
Contact
Toyota dealer
NO
Press the SAT
button.
Verify radio displays
SAT1,SAT2 or SAT3
YES
YES
Verify if SAT radio
displays either of
the following
messages for
more than 1
minute.
"No Antenna"
"No Sig nal"
NO
Verify if SAT radio
displays only
Channels 0, 184, 2 55
YES
Preview channels or
customer's
account may have expired.
Contact Sirius 1.800.539 .7474
NO
All Channels
Does the radio
display all channels
or only preview
channels?
Preview Channels
Verify the following can be viewed on
the radio display:
Channel number
Channel name
Song title
Artist name
Verify if the customer has
subscribed to the full
Sirius Service
NO
YES
NO
YES
Verify the following:
Volume
Balance (left & right aud io)
Channel presets
Seek/Tune
Verify the following can be viewed on
the radio display:
NO
Contact
Toyota dealer
NO
YES
Channel number
Channel name
Song title
Artist name
YES
Verify the following:
NO
Volume
Balance (left and right aud io)
Channel presets
Seek/Tune
YES
END OF DIAGNOSTICS
DOC-128-7446 Rev A
TOYOTA-SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO DIAGNOSTIC FLOWCHART
NOTE
The following tests should be
accomplished with the vehicle parked
outside in clear view of the sky.
Verify the installation of the
Sirius Receiver Assembly,
Antenna and Cable Harness before testing.
Turn ignition on (ACC).
Verify AM/FM operates
normally
INCLUDING
Turn off ignition.
Remove SAT cable harness
from back of radio unit.
NO
Volume
Balance (left & right audio)
Channel presets
Mute
YES
YES
Replacement
(Primary) Sirius receiver
(Secondary) Cable
harness
NO
Turn ignition on (ACC).
Verify AM/FM operates
normally
INCLUDING
Press the SAT
button.
Verify radio displays
SAT1,SAT2 or SAT3
NO
Volume
Balance (left & right audio)
Channel presets
Mute
YES
See Toyota radio
diagnostic repair
manual.
YES
Verify if SAT radio displays any
of the following for more than 1
minute.
Replacement
(Primary) Sirius antenna
(Secondary) Sirius
receiver
YES
Replacement
(Primary) Sirius receiver
(Secondary) Cable harness
No Signal
Antenna
Updating
Acquiring
NO
Tune to a preview
channel.
Verify the following:
Volume
Balance (left & right audio)
Channel presets
Mute
Verify if only
channels 0,184
and
255 are present.
NO
NO
YES
Preview channels or
customers
account may have expired.
Contact Sirius
1.800.539.7474.
YES
Verify the following can be viewed on
display:
Channel number
Channel name
Song title
Artist name
Replacement
NO
Sirius receiver
YES
Tune to channel 255 and verify the SID
number can be viewed on display.
NO
YES
END OF DIAGNOSTICS
DOC-128-7425 Rev A
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
DVD Rear Seat
Entertainment System
Diagnostic Manual
MDC # 00107-00358
DVD Diagnostics - 1
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The Rear Seat Entertainment (RSE) System consists of five basic components: (See Figure 1.
RSE Main Component Layout)
1. The Flat Panel Display (FPD) Screen
2. The DVD player, located in the Center Console
3. FM Modulator, located beneath the Vehicle Radio
4. Remote Control
5. Wireless IR (Infra-red) Headphones
The RSE System can display video from two sources: DVD Video Disc and AUX inputs. Audio can
be heard on the Vehicle Speakers, Wireless Headphones and Wired Headphones. AUX Video and
Audio Input jacks are located on the front of the DVD Player Console.
For disassembly instructions, refer to RSE Installation Instructions: PT900-8903D-03/16
PT900-8903S-03/16
Pre-Check
1. Confirm that the Vehicle Battery voltage is 10.5 volts minimum. If the Battery is below 10.5
volts, the system is designed to shut down to avoid discharging the Battery.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC/ON position, turn system ON by opening the FPD
Screen and by pressing the Power button on the DVD Player or on the Remote Control.
Check that the TOYOTA Logo appears on the FPD Screen.
RSE Status Indicator Light
The Status Indicator Light, located between the power and play/pause buttons on the DVD Player,
alerts the user to various functions or problems of the RSE. The Status Indicator Light will be
Green when the RSE is on standby or is playing. In case of an error, the Status Indicator Light will
blink until the error is corrected, up to a maximum-programmed time. The various states of the
Status Indicator Light are as follows:
Status Indicator Light OFF: The Green Light is OFF when the system is turned OFF.
Green Status Indicator Light: A steady Green Light indicates normal operation.
Status Indicator Light Blinking: The RSE system is programmed with six different Status
Indicator Light blink sequences, which can be used to troubleshoot the RSE system. The blink
sequences and indications are as follows:
1. One Blink - Power Failure (ACC abnormal power OFF) (Go to Step A1)
2. Two Blinks - Voltage Over Limit. (Out of range from 9 to 16 volts) (Go to Step A2)
3. Three Blinks - Temperature Over Limit. (Go to Step A3)
4. Four Blinks - Communication Error between CIM and FPD (Go to Step A4)
5. Five Blinks - Rotational Angle of the FPD is less than 20 degrees (Go to Step A5)
6. Six Blinks - Communication Error between CIM and DVD (Go to Step A6)
Blinking Status Indicator Light Quick Troubleshooting Guide
A1
Blink Sequence
The Status Indicator Light is blinking in a steady sequence
ON/OFF - ON/OFF
300 mSec
On
1
Blink
300 mSec
On
1 Second
Off
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 1 of 38 pages
Indication
Solution
There is a power
failure related to
an ACC abnormal
power off
Proceed with
Symptom B1
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 2
The minimum or
maximum voltage
operating range of
the RSE has been
exceeded. Prior to
the blinking
sequence, the
FPD screen will
display “VOLT
LIMIT Shutdown
in 5 Sec.”.
The minimum or
maximum
operating
temperature range
of the RSE has
been exceeded.
Prior to the
blinking
sequence, the
FPD screen will
display “TEMP
LIMIT Shutdown
in 5 Sec.”.
The Status Indicator Light is blinking in a steady sequence
ON/ON/OFF - ON/ON/OFF
A2
300 mSec
On
2
Blinks
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
1 Second
Off
The Status Indicator Light is blinking in a steady sequence
ON/ON/ON/OFF - ON/ON/ON/OFF
A3
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
On
3
Blinks
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
1 Second
Off
The Status Indicator Light is blinking in a steady sequence
ON/ON/ON/ON/OFF- ON/ON/ON/ON/OFF
300 mSec
On
A4
4
Blinks
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
There is a
communication
error between the
CIM and FPD
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
1 Second
Off
The Status Indicator Light is blinking in a steady sequence
ON/ON/ON/ON/ON/OFF - ON/ON/ON/ON/ON/OFF
300 mSec
On
A5
5
Blinks
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
1 Second
Off
The Status Indicator Light is blinking in a steady sequence
ON/ON/ON/ON/ON/ON/OFF - ON/ON/ON/ON/ON/ON/OFF
300 mSec
On
A6
6
Blinks
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
Issue: A 01/12/04
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
300 mSec
On
300 mSec
Off
Page 2 of 38 pages
300 mSec
On
1 Second
Off
Verify Battery
Voltage to be
between 10.5
and 15.8 VDC.
Shutdown the
RSE system
and allow time
for the system
to either cool
down or allow
time for the
system to
warm up.
Proceed with
Symptom B1
The rotational
angle of the FPD
is less than 20º
Open the FPD
Screen greater
than the 20º
minimum
viewing angle.
There is a
communication
error between the
CIM and DVD
Proceed with
Symptom B1
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 3
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Proceed with troubleshooting of each circuit in the table below.
Symptom
Suspect Area
1. Low Battery Voltage
2. Fuse
3. Connector/Cable
4. FPD
5. DVD Player
See Page
5
B1
No TOYOTA Logo, No Video, Dark Screen
B2
No Video Play but the TOYOTA Logo
appears on Screen
1. Remote Control
2. Remote Control Batteries
3. DVD Player
9
B3
Poor Video Quality
1. DVD Disc
2. DVD Player
3. FPD Assembly
10
B4
No Video in AUX mode when external source
is provided but DVD mode functions
properly
1. Remote Control
2. DVD Player
11
1. FM Modulator (FMM) is OFF
2. Vehicle Radio is not tuned to
FMM frequency
3. Antenna Cable from FMM is
not plugged into Vehicle
Radio.
4. FM Modulator
5. Connector/Cable
6. Remote Control
7. DVD Player
1. Wireless
Headphones
Batteries
2. Wireless IR Headphones
3. FPD Assembly
B5
No Audio on Vehicle Speakers, while the
Audio on Wireless IR and or Wired
Headphones is OK
B6
No Audio on Wireless IR Headphones
B7
No Audio on Wired Headphones, while the
Audio on Wireless IR and or Vehicle
Speakers is OK
1. Wired Headphones
2. DVD Player
17
B8
Disc plays, but will not eject
1. DVD Player
18
B9
DVD Player will not accept disc.
TOYOTA logo appears on the screen
1. DVD Player
19
B10
DVD System will not respond to any of the
remote control functions, but TOYOTA Logo
appears on FPD and/or DVD disc auto starts
and/or FPD shows Disc menu when the
IG/ACC is ON
1. Remote Control
2. Remote Control Batteries
3. FPD Assembly
20
The Dome Light in the FPD does not work
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
22
B11
Issue: A 01/12/04
The
Page 3 of 38 pages
Light Bulb
Dome light Cable/Connector
FPD Assembly
Main Harness/Fuse
Vehicle Battery
12
15
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 4
B12
DVD disc will not resume last position after
the vehicle has been turned OFF and then
turned ON again
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 4 of 38 pages
1. Vehicle Radio Fuse #2 (25
Amp)
2. Vehicle Wire Harness
3. RSE Main Wire Harness
25
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 5
B1
SYMPTOM: No TOYOTA Logo, No Video, Dark Screen
1
Check the Vehicle Radio for Power and Sound.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
Check that the DVD Player backlight turns on by pressing the power
button. The Power button should glow RED while the Play/Pause and
the Stop/Eject buttons glow bright GREEN. Ignition Switch must be in
the ACC/ON position with the FPD Screen down.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
Go to step 7
3
Check Vehicle Radio Fuse #1 (7.5 Amp) and Radio Fuse #2 (25 Amp)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
Go to step 10
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 5 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 6
4
Check the two (5 Amp) Fuses on the B+ and ACC input power lines
NG
Go to step
Replace
Fuse(s) and Retest
OK
5
Check the B+ and ACC voltages on Pins 1 and 3 and continuity to
ground on Pin 2 of connector P13
NG
Go to step
Replace
T-Harness
OK
6
Check the B+ and ACC voltages on Pins 1 and 2 and continuity to
ground on Pin 3 on connector P21 of the DVD Player.
NG
OK
7
Thetoharness
Go
step from the DVD Player to the
Input Power connector is defective
Replace RSE Main Wire Harness
Disconnect P12 and check the +7.5 voltage on Pin 1 and continuity to
ground on Pin 2.
NG
Go to step
Replace
DVD Player
OK
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 6 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 7
8
Reconnect P12 to the DVD Player and disconnect P103 of the FPD.
Check the +7.5 voltage on Pin 1 and continuity to ground on Pin 2.
NG
The
harness
Go to
step from the DVD Player to the
FPD is defective.
Replace RSE Main Wire Harness.
OK
9
Replace FPD.
End
10
For 8 Speaker System: Check B+ and ACC voltages on Pins 1 and 11
and continuity to ground on Pin 20 of connector J303
For 6 Speaker System: Check B+ and ACC voltages on Pins 4 and 3
and continuity to ground on Pin 7 of connector J305
NG
Go to step
Check
Vehicle Main Harness
OK
11
For 8 Speaker System: Check B+ and ACC voltages on Pins 1 and 11
and continuity to ground on Pin 20 of connector P302
For 6 Speaker System: Check B+ and ACC voltages on Pins 4 and 3
and continuity to ground on Pin 7 of connector P304
NG
Go to step
Replace
T-Harness
OK
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 7 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 8
Go to step 1
12
For 8 speaker systems, Disconnect P302, Replace Blown Fuse(s) and
Re-check Vehicle Radio Fuse #1 (7.5 Amp) and Radio Fuse #2 (25 Amp)
For 6 speaker systems, Disconnect P304, Replace Blown Fuse(s) and
Re-check Vehicle Radio Fuse #1 (7.5 Amp) and Radio Fuse #2 (25 Amp)
NG
Go to step 13
OK
Go to step 1
13
Replace T-Harness and Re-test
NG
Go to step
Vehicle
Radio not working properly
OK
Go to step 1
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 8 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 9
B2
SYMPTOM: No Video Play but the TOYOTA Logo appears on
Screen.
If the logo appears, this signifies that power is available at the FPD. This condition focuses our
attention on the DVD player.
1
Check the DVD System response to the Remote Control commands.
Pressing the Source button on the remote will activate either the DVD
or AUX mode and display the mode in the center of the screen for
approximately two seconds
NG
Go to B10
step Remote Control Problems
OK
2
Insert a DVD disc and verify it is accepted. The video will start playing
or the disc menu will appear on the screen
NG
Go to step
Replace
DVD Player
OK
End.
System Functions Properly
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 9 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 10
B3
SYMPTOM: Poor Video Quality.
1
Check video performance with various DVD discs.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
End.
Go
to step
First DVD disc is defective.
System OK.
2
Check external video performance. Press the Source button on the
remote control to activate AUX mode and connect an external video
source to the AUX input on the DVD console
NG
Go to step 3
OK
Go to step
Replace
DVD Player
3
Disconnect P12 and P103. Verify continuity between each pin of the
connectors.
NG
Harness
from the DVD Player to the
Go to step
FPD is defective.
Replace RSE Main Wire Harness
OK
Replace
FPD Assembly
Go
to step
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 10 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 11
B4
SYMPTOM: No Video in AUX mode when external source is
connected, but DVD mode functions properly
1
Check the DVD system response to the remote control commands.
Pressing the Source button on the remote will activate either the DVD
or AUX mode and display the mode in the center of the screen for
approximately two seconds
NG
Go to B10
step Remote Control Problems
OK
2
Check the AUX with external source and confirm video appears on
screen
NG
Go to step
Replace
the DVD Player
OK
End.
System Functions Properly
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 11 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 12
B5
SYMPTOM: No Audio on Vehicle Speakers, but Audio is
present on Wireless and/or Wired Headphones
1
Check that the FM Modulator is turned ON. Using the Remote Control,
press the FMM ON/OFF Button. The screen will display FMM ON or OFF
NG
Go
to step
B10, Remote Control Problems
Go to
OK
2
Check that the Vehicle Radio is turned ON and tuned to the same FM
Modulator Frequency
NG
Tune the Vehicle Radio to the correct
FM Modulator frequency.
OK
3
Check if Audio is present on Vehicle Speakers
NG
Go to step 4
OK
End.
System Functions Properly
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 12 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 13
4
Check that the Connectors P20 and P307 are properly connected to the
DVD Player and FM Modulator.
NG
Go to step and Re-Test at Step 3
Re-connect
OK
5
Disconnect Connector P20 and check the voltage on Pin 1 (+7.5 Volts)
and continuity to ground on Pins 6 and 7
NG
Go to step
Replace
DVD Player
OK
6
Re-connect Connector P20 and disconnect Connector P307. Check
voltage on Pin 1 (+7.5 Volts) and continuity to ground on Pins 6 and 7.
NG
The
harness
Go to
step from the DVD Player to the
FM Modulator is defective. Replace the
RSE Main Wire Harness.
OK
7
Verify that the Vehicle Antenna is connected into the FM Modulator and
that the FM Modulator is connected into the Vehicle Radio
NG
Connect
Vehicle Antenna to the FM
Go to step
Modulator and/or FM Modulator to the
Radio
OK
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 13 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 14
8
Disconnect P307 and P20. Verify continuity between each pin of the
connectors.
NG
The
harness
Go to
step from the DVD player to the
FM Modulator is defective.
Replace the RSE Main Wire Harness.
OK
Replace FM Modulator
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 14 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 15
B6
SYMPTOM: No Audio on TOYOTA Wireless IR Headphones
1
Check that the Red LED Indicator, on the Wireless Headphones, turns
ON when the IR Headphones are turned ON
NG
Replace
batteries and go to step 1
Go to step
OK
2
Check that the FPD IR Transmitter is turned ON in the System Menu.
Press System Menu button on the Remote Control
NG
Press the System Menu button on the
Remote Control.
Press the T button 3 times then the X
button 1 time to change the IR
Transmitter from OFF to ON
OK
3
Check Audio with a second Wireless IR Headphone.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
System functions properly.
The first headphone was
not working properly.
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 15 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 16
4
Check the Audio using a pair of Wired Headphones. NOTE:
Headphone Jacks are located on the front of the DVD Player
NG
Wired
Go to step
Replace
DVD Player
OK
Replace FPD
(IR Transmitter not working
properly).
5
Disconnect P12 and P103, Verify continuity between each pin of the
connectors.
NG
The harness from the DVD player to the
FM Modulator is defective.
Replace the RSE Main Wire Harness.
OK
Replace FPD
(IR Transmitter not working
properly).
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 16 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 17
B7
SYMPTOM: No Audio on Wired Headphones
1
Verify that the System Audio is not muted. Press the Mute button on
the Remote Control and the screen will display if the system is muted
or not
NG
Turn
Go toOFF
stepMute mode
OK
2
Check Audio on Wireless IR Headphones.
NG
Go to step
SYMTOM B6
OK
3
Check both Headphone Jacks, on the DVD Console, with an alternate
Wired Headphone
NG
Go to step
Replace
DVD player
OK
Original Wired Headphone
is not functioning properly.
Replace Headphones.
End.
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 17 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 18
B8
SYMPTOM: DVD plays disc, but will not Eject
1
With the ignition switch in the ACC/ON position. Power System ONOFF-ON with the Remote Control or by pressing the Power button on
the DVD Player and then Stop, to stop the playback of the Disc, then
Press Eject.
NG
Replace
DVD Player
Go to step
OK
End.
System functions properly
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 18 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 19
B9
SYMPTOM: DVD Player will not accept Disc, but the TOYOTA
Logo appears on the screen
1
Verify that the Disc is inserted properly. The label of the disc should be
facing the driver upon insertion into the DVD slot.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
End.
System functions properly
2
With the ignition switch in the ACC/ON position. Power System ONOFF-ON with the Remote Control or by pressing the Power button on
the DVD Player and then Stop, to stop the playback of the Disc, then
Press Eject.
NG
Replace
DVD Player
Go to step
OK
End.
System functions properly
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 19 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 20
B10
SYMPTOM: DVD System will not respond to the Remote
Control. TOYOTA Logo appears on the screen or DVD disc
auto starts or displays Disc Menu when the IGN/ACC is ON
1
Check that the remote control can select DVD and AUX modes and all
other button functions. After pressing the Source button on the
Remote Control, either DVD or AUX will be displayed on the screen.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
System functions properly
2
Install a New Battery in the Remote Control and Re-test
NG
Go to step 3
OK
System functions properly
3
Try control functions of New Remote Control.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 20 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 21
Original Remote Control did
not function properly.
4
Disconnect P12 and P103. Verify continuity between each pin of the
connectors.
NG
The
harness
Go to
step from the DVD Player to the
FPD is defective.
Replace the RSE Main Wire Harness
OK
Replace the FPD
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 21 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 22
B11
SYMPTOM: The Dome Light in the FPD does not work
1
Switch the Dome Light Rocker Switch to the ON position and the Dome
Light turns ON
NG
Go to step 2
OK
Dome Light works properly.
End.
2
Remove the Dome Light Cover and verify that the Dome Light Bulb is
properly inserted into the Bulb Socket
NG
Either
the bulb was inserted improperly
Go to step
or the bulb was not inserted at all. Reinsert bulb and Re-test
OK
3
Remove and Replace the Dome Light Bulb
NG
Go to step 4
OK
Dome light works, first bulb
was defective
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 22 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 23
4
Check the 10 Amp Dome Light Fuse
NG
Replace
Fuse and Retest
Go to step
OK
5
Disconnect the FPD to expose the Dome Light Wire Harness. Verify
that the Dome Light Wire Harness is properly connected to the vehicle
Main Wire Harness
NG
Connect
Dome Light Harness to Vehicle
Go to step
Main Wire Harness and Re-test
OK
6
Disconnect the Dome Light connector and verify that +12 VDC exists on
Pins 1 and 2 and continuity to ground on Pin 3
NG
Go
Go to
to step
step 7
OK
Dome Light Circuit is
defective. Replace FPD
7
Verify Battery Voltage is approximately 12 VDC.
NG
Issue: A 01/12/04
Battery
Discharged. Re-charge Battery.
Go to step
Re-test.
Page 23 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 24
OK
Vehicle Main Wire Harness
is defective. Replace
Harness
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 24 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 25
B12
SYMPTOM: DVD disc will not resume last position after the
vehicle has been turned OFF and then turned ON again
This symptom concentrates on the B+ Input Power Line. While in the middle of disc Playback, the
vehicle is shut OFF, the DVD Players Memory will mark the last position of the disc and will
resume Playback from that point upon power up.
1
Power up the RSE System. Insert a disc into the DVD Player. Skip
forward two chapters into the video by pressing the next button twice
on the remote control. Shut off the vehicle and wait 5 seconds. Turn
the vehicle back ON. The video should resume from the point where
the video last left off.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
End.
System functions properly
2
Check the Vehicle Radio #2 Fuse (25 Amp)
NG
Replace Fuse and Re-test
OK
3
For 8 Speaker System: Check B+ voltages on Pins 1 of J303
For 6 Speaker System: Check B+ voltages on Pins 4 of J305
NG
Check Vehicle Main Wire Harness
OK
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 25 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 26
4
Check the B+ voltage on Pin 1 of connector P13
NG
Go to step 6
OK
5
Check the B+ voltage on Pin 2 of connector P21
NG
Replace
RSE Main Wire Harness.
Go to step
Harness is defective
OK
End.
Replace DVD Player.
DVD Player not functioning
properly
6
Check the 5 Amp fuses on the T-Harness
NG
Replace fuse (s) and Re-test
OK
Replace T-Harness and
Re-test
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 26 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 27
RSE Main Component Layout
Figure 1. RSE Main Component Layout (Non-Sunroof)
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 27 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 28
Connection Locations on the FM Modulator and DVD Player
P307
Figure 2. FM Modulator Connections
P21
P12
P20
Figure 3. DVD Player Connections
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 28 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 29
DISC Slot
Power
Button
Status
Indicator
Light
PLAY/
PAUSE
STOP/
EJECT
Video
Input
Audio
Left
Input
Audio
Right
Input
Wired
Headphone
Jacks
Figure 4. DVD Player Front Face Plate
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 29 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 30
RSE Wire Harness/Connector Location
(Non-Sunroof)
Figure 5. RSE Connector/Wire Harness Location
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 30 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 31
RSE Wire Harness/Connector Location
(Sunroof)
Figure 6. RSE Connector/Wire Harness Location
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 31 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 32
RSE Wire Diagram (6 Speaker)
RADIO No.2 25A (B+)
MAIN
FUSE
RADIO No.1 7.5A (Acc)z
VEHICLE WIRE HARNESS
1
2
5
6
4
3
J305
7
UP PILLAR "A"
BATTERY
P103
P12
P304
1
STANDARD
RADIO
6 SPEAKER
P21
2
5
6
J14
F1
5A
4
1 1
5A
3
F2
7
3 3
2 2
DVD
B+
2
Acc
1
GND
3
6
P13
ANTENNA
INPUT
1
2
POWER-7.5V
3
4
5
IR-GND
1
2
GND
3
4
5
IR-IN
IR-5V
D-GND
6
8
9
10
D-TXD
D-RXD
D-ACK
7
14
A-GND
11
12
13
AUDIO-R
AUDIO-L
GND-DOME
3-PIN MALE
CONNECTOR
P20
RING
GND
DIVERSITY
Tx
IR FOR
WIRELESS
Rx
REMOTE
EYE
7
14
VIDEO
V-GND
11
12
13
DISPLAY
(FPD)
6
8
9
10
DOMELIGHT
375N
GND-DOME
3
1
2
EXISTING
3-PIN FEMALE
CONNECTOR
722N
P307
FMM
1
6
7
8
3
2
9
5
10
4
POWER-DOME
POWER-7.5V
1
SW-GND-DOME
GND
GND
2
EXISTING
2-PIN FEMALE
CONNECTOR
FM-CE
FM-DA
FM-CK
D-GND
AUDIO-R
2-PIN MALE
CONNECTOR
DOOR
SWITCH
AUDIO-L
A-GND
CONNECTORS/NOTES
1. J14=(3 PIN)
2. P13= (3 PIN)
3. P12=(14 PIN)
4. P103= (14 PIN)
5. P20= (10 PIN)
6. P21= ( 6 PIN)
7. P307=(10 PIN)
8. J305= (10 PIN)
9. P304= (10 PIN)
Figure 7. RSE Wire Diagram (6 Speaker)
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 32 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 33
RSE Wire Diagram (8 Speaker)
MAIN
FUSE
RADIO No.2 25A (B+)
VEHICLE WIRE HARNESS
RADIO No.1 7.5A (Acc)z
2 4 5 6 12 14 15
9
J303
8 19 18 16 7 17 10 3 13 1 11 20
BATTERY
P103
P12
P302
P21
J14
F1
5A
2
4
5
6
12
14
15
STANDARD
RADIO
8 SPEAKER
UP PILLAR "A"
1 1
B+
2
F2
5A
3 3
9
8
19
18
16
7
17
10
3
13
Acc
1
DVD
1
2
POWER-7.5V
3
4
5
IR-GND
GND
2 2
3
P13
6
1
11
20
IR-5V
D-GND
6
8
9
10
D-TXD
D-RXD
D-ACK
VIDEO
V-GND
A-GND
11
12
13
AUDIO-R
AUDIO-L
RING
GND
DISPLAY
(FPD)
Tx
IR FOR
WIRELESS
Rx
REMOTE
EYE
7
14
11
12
13
DOMELIGHT
375N
GND-DOME
DIVERSITY
6
8
9
10
GND-DOME
3-PIN MALE
CONNECTOR
P20
ANTENNA
INPUT
3
4
5
IR-IN
7
14
GND
1
2
3
1
2
EXISTING
3-PIN FEMALE
CONNECTOR
722N
POWER-DOME
P307
1
SW-GND-DOME
FMM
1
6
7
8
3
2
9
5
10
4
2
POWER-7.5V
EXISTING
2-PIN FEMALE
CONNECTOR
GND
GND
FM-CE
FM-DA
FM-CK
D-GND
DOOR
SWITCH
AUDIO-R
AUDIO-L
A-GND
CONNECTORS
1. J14= (3 PIN)
2. P13= (3 PIN)
3. P12= (14 PIN)
4. P103= (14 PIN)
5. P20= (10 PIN)
6. P21= ( 6 PIN)
7. P307= (10 PIN)
8. J303= (20 PIN)
9. P302= (20 PIN)
Figure 8. RSE Wire Diagram (8 Speaker)
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 33 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 34
Dome Light
Connector
FPD
FPD / IR
Connector
Figure 9 FPD Connector Locations
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 34 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 35
Connector Tables
PIN #
Function
1
FR+
2
FL+
Green 20#
3
ACC
Red 20#
4
B+
White 20#
5
FR-
Yellow 20#
6
7
FLGND
Blue 20#
Black 20#
PIN #
Function
1
FR+
Connector # J305
6 speaker T-harness (Power End)
Connector # P304
6 speaker T-harness (Radio End)
Color/Gauge
Brown 20#
Color/Gauge
Brown 20#
2
FL+
Green 20#
3
ACC
Red 20#
4
B+
White 20#
5
FR-
Yellow 20#
6
7
FLGND
Blue 20#
Black 20#
PIN #
Function
1
B+
Connector # J303
8 speaker T-harness (Power End)
Color/Gauge
2
-
White/Black 20#
3
AMP
Violet 20#
4
-
White/Red 20#
White 20#
5
6
-
White/Green 20#
7
MUTE
Brown 20#
8
FR
Red 20#
9
FL
Yellow 20#
10
SGDE
Shield
11
ACC
Red 20#
12
-
White/Yellow 20#
13
ANT
Gray 20#
14
-
White/Blue 20#
15
-
White/Orange 20#
16
SGND
Black 20#
17
BEEP
Orange 20#
18
RR
Green 20#
19
RL
Blue 20#
20
GND
Black 20#
Issue: A 01/12/04
Page 35 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 36
PIN #
Function
1
B+
Connector # P302
8 speaker T-harness (Radio End)
Color/Gauge
2
-
White/Black 20#
3
AMP
Violet 20#
4
-
White/Red 20#
White 20#
5
6
-
White/Green 20#
7
MUTE
Brown 20#
8
FR
Red 20#
9
FL
Yellow 20#
10
SGDE
Shield
11
ACC
Red 20#
12
-
White/Yellow 20#
13
ANT
Gray 20#
14
-
White/Blue 20#
15
-
White/Orange 20#
16
SGND
Black 20#
17
BEEP
Orange 20#
18
RR
Green 20#
19
20
RL
GND
Blue 20#
Black 20#
PIN #
Function
1
B+
2
GND
Black 20#
3
ACC
Red 20#
PIN #
Function
1
B+
2
GND
Black 20#
3
ACC
Red 20#
Issue: A 01/12/04
Connector P13
T-Harness to 6 & 8 Speaker Power
Connector J14
T-Harness Power to DVD Power
Page 36 of 38 pages
Color/Gauge
White 20#
Color/Gauge
White 20#
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 37
PIN #
Function
1
ACC
Red 20#
2
B+
White 20#
3
GND
Black 20#
4
NC
5
NC
6
GND
PIN #
Function
1
POWER-7.5V
2
GND
Connector P21
Power to DVD
Color/Gauge
Drain
Connector P12, P103
DVD to FPD
Color/Gauge
Red 20#
Black 20#
3
IR-GND
Black 26#
4
IR-IN
Brown 26#
5
IR-5V
Red 26#
6
D-GND
Black 26#
7
VIDEO
Coax, conductor
8
D-TXD
Brown 26#
9
D-RXD
Red 26#
10
D-ACK
Orange 26#
11
A-GND
Black 26#
12
AUDIO-R
Red 26#
13
14
AUDIO-L
V-GND
Brown 26#
Coax, shield
PIN #
Function
1
Power-7.5V
2
FM-CK
Red 24#
3
FM-DA
White 24#
4
A-GND
Black 24#
5
AUDIO-R
Red 24#
6
GND
Black 20#
7
GND
White 20#
8
FM-CE
Green 24#
9
D-GND
Black 24#
10
AUDIO-L
White 24#
Issue: A 01/12/04
Connector P20, P307
DVD to FM Modulator
Page 37 of 38 pages
Color/Gauge
Red 20#
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
DVD Diagnostics - 38
PIN #
Function
F1-A
Power B+
F2-A
Power ACC
Issue: A 01/12/04
Connector P20, P307
Power and Memory Fuses
Color/Gauge
White 20#
Red 20#
Page 38 of 38 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TROUBLESHOOTING
20034RUNNER TVIP V5
INFORMATION
RS3200 PLUS
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
RS3200PLUS AVALON/CAMRY/HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
CONNECTOR1
CIRCUIT
MEASUREMENT
1 - Ground
SUB +B Power (Dome)
Always Approx. 12V
2 - Ground
+B Power (Dome)
Always Approx. 12V
3
Trunk Key Input
Continuity when key turned to open
4 - Ground
Key Unlock Warning Input
Continuity when key is in the ignition switch
5
N/C
6 - Ground
7 - Ground
G.B.S. Input
8 - Ground
N/C
9 - Ground
N/C
10
MPX signal
11 Ground
ECU Ground
Continuity
12 - Ground
LED Output
Approx. 1.8V when LED on, 0V when LED off 0V during triggering
13 - Ground
Starter Cut Input
Approx. 12V when ignition switch at ST position, 0V during
triggering
14 Ground
IG Input
15
0V (Pulsed) when window hit
Approx. 12V when ignition switch is in ON position
N/C
16
N/C
17
N/C
18
N/C
19
N/C
20
N/C
21
N/C
22
N/C
23
N/C
24
N/C
25
N/C
26 - Ground
Starter Cut Output
Approx 12V when ignition switch is in ON position
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS AVALON/ CAMRY/ HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: Remote Control Inoperative
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Key Unlock wire, weak or dead battery in remote, remote programmed improperly (see KNOWN
ISSUES page), remote not programmed, connectors not plugged in securely.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the panic mode
operation work?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the key unlock warning wire’s splice location (does
not apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Clear the remote control codes from the ECU, then reprogram both (or
all) remotes (they may have accidentally been programmed for second
channel output).
No
control(s) and carefully clean the battery and contacts, then check the
battery for a minimum 2.7V during remote operation. Replace the battery
if necessary.
Clear the remote control codes from the ECU, then reprogram both (or
all) remotes (they may have accidentally been programmed for second
channel output).
Check the automatic door locking/unlocking function.
Open
the
remote
Do the vehicle’s door
Yes
locks work with the door
switches or key?
No
Check and correct the key unlock warning wire’s splice location (does not
apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Confirm the door lock control connectors are plugged in securely. Disconnect the RS3200PLUS harness’ Door Lock Control connectors and reconnect the vehicle’s connectors, then try again, If there is no function, there
is probably a problem with one vehicle’s components.
RS3200PLUS AVALON/ CAMRY/ HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: System Inoperative (No Remote Arming/Disarming)
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Key Unlock Warning wire, mis-spliced door courtesy wire, connectors not plugged in securely, Fuse
or shortpin not installed in vehicle, blown fuse in RS3200PLUS harness (does not apply to all vehicles).
What to Ask and Verify
Do the vehicle’s door
Yes
locks work with the door
switches or key?
No
What to Check
Check and correct the key unlock warning wire’s splice location (does not
apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Confirm the door lock control connectors are plugged in securely. Disconnect the RS3200PLUS harness’ Door Lock Control connectors and reconnect the vehicle’s connectors, then try again, If there is no function, there
is probably a problem with one vehicle’s components.
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS AVALON/CAMRY/HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: No Head Light Function
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Head Lamp wire, connectors not plugged in securely, blown Head Lamp fuse.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the head lamp
switch in the vehicle
work?
Is there continuity
between pin 10 of the
RS3200PLUS harness’
ECU connector?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the head light wire’s splice location (applies to most
vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Check for continuity between the RS3200PLUS ECU connector and the
head lamp circuit connection.
No
Check the vehicle’s head lamp fuse and replace if necessary.
Confirm that the combination switch connector for the head lamp circuit is
plugged in securely.
Yes
Activate the panic mode and check pin 10 for pulsed continuity to ground.
If there is continuity, check fix the wire harness.
Check the RS3200PLUS ECU for signs of liquid damage; it may be necessary to open the ECU case. LIQUID DAMAGE ITEMS ARE NOT COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
No
If no continuity, there is a wire harness problem. Fix as necessary.
RS3200PLUS AVALON/CAMRY/HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: No Horn Function
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Horn wire, connectors not plugged in securely, blown Horn fuse.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the horn switch in
the vehicle work?
Is there continuity
on pin 10 of the
RS3200PLUS harness’
ECU connector?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the horn wire’s splice location (applies to most
vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Check for continuity between the RS3200PLUS ECU connector and the
horn circuit connection.
No
Check the vehicle’s horn fuse and replace if necessary.
Confirm that the combination switch connector for the horn circuit is
plugged in securely.
Yes
Activate the panic mode and check pin 10 for pulsed continuity to ground.
If there is continuity, check fix the wire harness or check BODY ECU
signal.
Check the RS3200PLUS ECU for signs of liquid damage; it may be necessary to open the ECU case. LIQUID DAMAGE ITEMS ARE NOT
COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
If no continuity, there is a wire harness problem. Fix as necessary.
No
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS AVALON/CAMRY/HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: No Tail Light Or Marker Light Operation
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Tail Light wire, connectors not plugged in securely, blown fuse.
What to Ask and Verify
Do the vehicle’s tail
lights work?
Is there continuity
on pin 10 of the
RS3200PLUS harness’
ECU connector?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the tail light wire’s splice location (applies to most
vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Verify the RS3200PLUS harness’ tail light circuit connectors are plugged
in securely.
Check for continuity between the RS3200PLUS ECU connector and the
tail light circuit connection.
No
Confirm that the vehicle’s connector for the tail light circuit is plugged
in securely.
Disconnect the RS3200PLUS harness’ tail light circuit connectors and
reconnect the vehicle’s connectors, then check the tail light function
again. If they work, check the RS3200PLUS harness. If not, the problem
is vehicle-related. (applies to some vehicles)
Activate the panic mode and check pin 10 for pulsed continuity to
ground. If there is continuity, check the RS3200PLUS ECU for signs of
liquid damage; it may be necessary to open the ECU case. LIQUID
DAMAGE ITEMS ARE NOT COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
Yes
No
Check and fix the RS3200PLUS harness.
RS3200PLUS AVALON/CAMRY/HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: LED Inoperative (No blinking, No turning on)
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced LED wire, mis-spliced door courtesy wire, connectors not plugged in securely.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the LED blink during arming?
Yes
No
What to Check
No problem.
Check trunk key switch was installed properly.
If not correct, LED may not turn on.
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS AVALON/CAMRY/HIGHLANDER SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: System Inoperative (Duplicate Panic Alarm)
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-connection of Panic signal wire with terminal, mis-spliced panic signal wire, connector not plugged
in securely.
What to Ask and Verify
What to Check
Does the duplicate panic Yes
mode operation work?
Check the panic signal wire’s splice location.
(Does not apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Confirm the panic signal wire with terminal location.
Check door lock control connector is plugged in securely.
No
No Problem
2005-
4RUNNER TVIP V2 GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR (GBS)
Troubleshooting
Information
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
G.B.S. Security System
CONNECTOR 1
1-GROUND
2-GROUND
3-GROUND
4-GROUND
5-GROUND
6-GROUND
7-GROUND
8-GROUND
CIRCUIT
+B Power (ECU-B)
N/C
G.B.S. Output
G.B.S. (Microphone) Input
G.B.S. (Microphone) Ground
GND
N/C
IG Input
1
4 5 6
MEASUREMENT
Always approx 12V
0V (pulsed) when window hit
0V (pulsed) when window hit
Continuity
Continuity
Approx. 12V when ignition switch is in ON position
3
8
CONNECTOR 1
G.B.S. Security System
Complaint: G.B.S. Inoperative (no alarm when window is hit)
Common causes for this complaint:
G.B.S. signal terminal not plugged in securely, sensitivity adjustment not properly set.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the alarm go off?
What to Check
Yes
No
No problem
Check the volume of the G.B.S. unit.
Confirm microphone location.
Verify the connection of the G.B.S. signal wire.
Accessory Installation Practices
Introduction
This document is written and maintained by Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc. as an aid to
defining accessory installation best practices.
Safety
1.1
Eye protection should be worn during any drilling and cutting, and when power tools are
used to remove or attach fasteners.
Eye protection should also be used when using any special chemicals (as listed on the first page
of the Installation Instruction Sheet) to reduce the risk of these chemicals entering the eye.
1.2
Rechecking of fastener tightness.
For some accessories it is necessary to recheck the tightness of the fasteners securing the
accessory, for example – wheel lug nuts, running board bolts, tow hitch bolts etc. Where a
recheck is required it will be noted in the Installation Instruction Sheet (either in the Procedure
Section and/or the Checklist Section)
1.3
Supplemental Restraint System SRS
Any vehicle equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS). Failure to carry out the
following procedures listed below could result in possible deployment of airbag, personal injury,
or unnecessary repairs to SRS.
1.3.1 Turn the key switch to the LOCK position.
1.3.2 Remove key from ignition switch.
1.3.3 Disconnect the negative battery cable.
1.3.4 Never use a voltmeter to troubleshoot any of the harnesses or connectors to the
SRS. Accidentally probing the connectors to the SRS can lead to deployment of the
airbag.
1.3.5 SRS wire harness loom/cover is bright yellow in color.
1.3.6 SRS contains a battery backup system; therefore ALWAYS wait for a minimum
of 90 seconds after disconnecting the battery negative cable before removal/disassembly
of electrical components. (Reference TSB: EL93-001).
Vehicle Protection
2.l
Vehicle should be clean before performing any accessory installation.
2.2
Prepare grille cover, fender cover, seat cover, and floor mat cover as appropriate to the
installation area on the vehicle of the accessory before starting installation. Blankets, seat
covers, paper floor coverings are suitable for this purpose.
Issue B
Page 1 of 4 pages
5/23/2006
2.3
Do not place any tools on unprotected vehicle surfaces, or leave inside vehicle. Use a
tool tray to keep tools separate from the vehicle surface.
2.4
It is recommended that no exposed jewelry (rings, watches etc.), zippers, buttons, rivets,
belt buckles or other scratch potential objects be worn. Articles of clothing or jewelry that have
the potential to come into contact with the vehicle surface (i.e., generally below the chest) and
contain any of the above items should be covered with tape and/or other protective material to
prevent scratching of the vehicle.
2.5.
Clothing and shoes must be free of grease and dirt to maximize vehicle cleanliness.
2.6
Parts and tool trays should be used for interior installations whenever possible. Parts,
tools or trays must not be placed onto unprotected, seats, carpets or trim panels.
2.7
Tools, air hoses and power cords should be free of grease and dirt.
2.8
Blanket should be used to cover engine bay while working on accessory that requires
hood to be open (e.g. Hood Protector) to prevent fasteners from being dropped into engine bay.
Vehicle Disassembly/Re-assembly
Panel Removal
3.1
Many panels on the vehicle are held in place with clips. Where the location of this clip is
critical it is shown on the figure(s) in the Installation Instruction Sheet. Care must be taken to
remove the panel and its clip(s) without damage. Toyota recommends use of plastic (nylon)
removal tools, rather than metal and two Toyota Special Service Tools are available:Panel Pry Tool #1 Toyota SST # 00002-06001-01
Panel Pry Tool #2 Toyota SST # 00002-06002-01
Panel Protection
3.2.
Place all removed parts on a protected surface.
3.3.
All work benches, tables, or platforms used for assembly or temporary storage of parts
should be carpeted or suitably covered to provide a soft, non-abrasive surface.
Parts Container
3.4
Use a small parts container to keep removed bolts and tapping screws so that they can be
reassembled correctly.
Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly
Battery Cable
4.1
Unless otherwise stated battery negative terminal must be disconnected and isolated
before performing work on any electrical components (i.e. connecting or disconnecting any
Issue B
Page 2 of 4 pages
5/23/2006
electrical connectors, etc.). In some installations fuse removal is used instead of battery terminal
disconnection, and will be referred to in the Installation Instruction Sheet.
4.2
Ignition key must be removed from the ignition switch when the negative battery
terminal or appropriate fuse is disconnected/removed and reconnected/reinstalled.
4.3
Do not touch the positive terminal with any tool when removing the negative battery
cable.
4.4
Use a fender cover (blanket) when connecting or disconnecting battery negative terminal
and/or when replacing or removing fuses. Ensure battery negative terminal is fully seated when
reconnecting.
4.5
Power tools that can exceed 60 pound force-inch of torque should not be used to tighten
battery cable. The torque value for battery cable tightening is given in the Installation Instruction
Sheet.
Connectors
4.4.
When disconnecting connectors, do not pull on the wires; pull on the connectors.
4.5.
DO NOT pull on vehicle wires and/or wire harnesses. To uncouple electrical connectors,
pull only on the connector itself and release the connector securing tab (identified in the
Installation Instruction Sheet).
4.6.
Disconnected wires must not have any strain on connectors or wires (i.e., do not allow
components hanging from a wire harness).
4.7.
When reconnecting connectors, ensure connectors are securely snapped together and
wires are not twisted or kinked.
Wire Harnesses
4.8. When installing the accessories that use wire harnesses (e.g. audio, alarm, trailer wire
harness…), make sure the harness is not cut or perforated by any sharp metal objects/edges.
Wire Ties
4.9.
When using wire ties to secure harness, clip the wire ties after securing them.
4.10. Ensure that wire routing does not interfere with movement of mechanical components
before tightening the wire tie.
Functional Checks
4.11. Functional checks (from the Checklist Section of the Installation Instruction Sheet) must
be performed on all disconnected electrical components.
Use of Special Chemicals
Cleaners
5.1
All cloths used for preparatory installations must be cleaned and periodically changed.
Any cloth that is dropped on the floor should not be used until cleaned.
Issue B
Page 3 of 4 pages
5/23/2006
5.2.
Cleaning solutions/solvents are identified in the Installation Instruction Sheet and are not
to be sprayed directly onto vehicle surfaces (interior/exterior).
5.3.
Cleaning solutions/solvents are not to be sprayed onto cloth/rag inside of vehicle (this is
to prevent over spray on interior).
5.4.
When using cleaners such as Prep-Solvent-70, or Household Windex follow
manufacturer’s recommendations:5.4.1 Always use a clean (lint free scratch resistant) soft cloth (or wipe), and clean a
small area at a time ( ~ 3 ft. x 3 ft. max.).
5.4.2 Shake well.
5.4.3 Apply cleaner to cloth or wipe. Do not spray cleaning solution directly on any
vehicle surfaces.
5.4.4 Clean surface thoroughly and wipe dry immediately with a new clean cloth. Do
not allow cleaner to air dry.
Sealers
5.5
Follow Installation Instruction Sheet recommendations.
5.6
For any cleanup follow sealer manufacturer recommendations.
Temperature
6.1.
Some accessories require installation in a controlled temperature environment. The
installation instructions will provide the temperature range of this temperature and will
differentiate between vehicle and accessory temperature (should it not be the same for both.)
6.2.
The installation location will be responsible for determining whether the temperature
range has been met.
6.3.
The method of temperature measurement will NOT be called out in the instructions.
6.4.
Recommended tools for measuring vehicle and accessory temperature are:Non-Intrusive IR Temperature Probe/Gun
6.5.
Recommended heating/cooling methods are:Heat box (for small components), Car HVAC, Heat Gun….
Torque Recheck
7.1.
When rechecking of a fastener torque is called out in the Installation Instruction Sheet it
is sufficient to ensure that the fastener does not rotate when the installation torque is reapplied.
If the fastener rotates then continue tightening until the specified torque is reached. Do not
loosen fastener.
Issue B
Page 4 of 4 pages
5/23/2006
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Preparation
Part Number: PT278-89063
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
1
2
1
Description
Bike Rack
Keys (in Bag)
DIO Instruction Sheet
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
3
Description
Adaptor Kit:
P/N PT278-89061 or
P/N PT278-35061 or
P/N PT278-35064
Conflicts
General Applicability
Note: Fits on all Toyota Fixed Roof Racks together with
an Adaptor Kit:
P/N PT278-89061: 4Runner, RAV4, Highlander, Land
Cruiser, Matrix, Sequoia, Sienna
P/N PT278-35061: Tacoma
P/N PT278-35064: FJ Cruiser
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
Accessory
Adaptors
Bike Rack
None
*Mandatory
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Vehicle Protection
Legend
Blankets
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
Screwdriver
Screwdriver
Flat Blade(~1”)
Philips #2
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not proceed
until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed in
order to reduce the risk of damage to the accessory/vehicle
and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Special Chemicals
None
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 1 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
1.
STOP
Installation Preparation
(a) Protect vehicle sides and roof panel with
protective blankets.
(b) Clean the vehicle Roof Rack from dirt and
dry.
2.
Fig. 2-1
Installation of Adaptors
(a) Open an Adaptor Assembly and slide it on
one the vehicle Roof Rack Cross Bars with
the opening facing backwards. (Fig. 2-1)
NOTE: Place two Adaptor Assemblies on the
vehicle Roof Rack Front Cross Bar and one on
the Rear Cross Bar.
(a) Adjust the position of the Adaptor
Assemblies so that they are 5.75" (146 mm)
apart center to center on the Front Cross
Bar. (Fig. 2-2)
Fig. 2-2
(1) The Adaptor Assembly on the Rear
Cross Bar should be in line with the
Adaptor on the Front Cross Bar that is
closest to the outside of the vehicle.
(Fig. 2-2)
NOTE: When adjusting the position of the
Adaptor Assemblies, make sure the rubber
gasket remains in place.
Fig. 2-3
(b) Fasten each Adaptor Assembly by spinning
the plastic lever and folding it down. (Figs.
2-3 & 2-4)
(1) Tighten the lever by hand until it is
snug and the Adaptor Assembly will
not slide by pushing and pulling by
hand.
Fig. 2-4
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 2 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
3.
Mounting the Bike Rack on the Adaptor
Assemblies
(a) Unlock the lever and move the frame holder
to the side and rotate the arm forward (Fig.
3-1).
Rear Wheel
NOTE: Rotating the arm completely forward
unlocks the front lever mechanism.
Front Wheel
Fig. 3-1
Upper Slots
(b) Open the three levers on the bike rack and
slide the rack into the slot on each adaptor.
Note: P/N PT278-89061 has two slots on
each of the Adaptor Assemblies:
(1) The Bike Rack is mounted to the two
upper slots of the front Adaptor
Assemblies. (Fig. 3-2)
(2) The Bike Rack is mounted to the upper
slot of the rear Adaptor Assembly.
(Fig. 3-3)
Fig. 3-2
(c) Adjust the clamping force by spinning the
levers in a vertical position then close the
levers. (Fig. 3-4)
NOTE: Arm must point forward almost
parallel with the wheel track in-order for both of
the two front levers to unlock.
Upper Slot
Fig. 3-3
Front
Fig. 3-4
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 3 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
4.
Fastening the Bike
(a) Place the bike in the wheel track. To
facilitate, unlatch and fold the straps out of
the way. (Fig. 4-1)
(b) Rotate the arm towards the bicycle frame.
Turn and adjust the frame holder to fit the
frame. (Fig. 4-2)
Fig. 4-1
STOP
3.15”
(c) When the frame holder is adjusted to the
frame, tighten by folding the lever up in the
unlatched position as shown and spin it to
set the correct clamping force. (Fig. 4-3)
(1) When the frame is attached firmly, lock
the lever
Fig. 4-2
NOTE: Light weight frames may be damaged if
too much force is used.
Do NOT spin in this position
8
Fig. 4-3
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 4 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
5.
Fastening the Wheels
(a) Adjust the position of the rear wheel holder
by sliding it, then tighten the strap around
the rear wheel. (Fig. 5-1)
STOP
Fig. 5-1
(b) Tighten the strap on the front wheel, making
sure the strap runs round the wheel and
through the holder in the profile. Fold the
strap into the strap holder underneath to
prevent it from hanging down and
interfering with the roof. (Fig. 5-2)
(c) When driving without a bike, lock the frame
holder to the parking post. (Fig. 5-3)
Fig. 5-2
Fig. 5-3
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 5 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
6.
Switching Installation Side
(a) To be able to attach more than two bike
racks on the roof, the frame holder tube and
the attachments have to switch sides. (Fig.
6-1)
(b) When more than two bike racks are fitted
the bike rack positions alternate. (Fig. 6-2)
Fig. 6-1
Fig. 6-2
7.
Switching Side of the Frame Holder Tube
(a) Open the levers close to the tube and fold
the tube up to vertical position. (Fig. 7-1)
(b) Unscrew (¼ turn) and pull out the socket
cap.(Fig. 7-2)
Fig. 7-1
Flat Blade
Screwdriver
Fig. 7-2
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 6 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
(c) Make sure the wedge is in the correct
position by lining up the “diamond” marks.
(Fig. 7-3)
(d) Pull up the wedge, press from below and
remove. (Fig. 7-4)
Fig. 7-3
(e) Pull out the tube and insert it from the other
side. (Fig. 7-5)
(f) After inserting the tube (1), re assemble the
wedge (2) and the socket cap (3). (Fig. 7-6)
Fig. 7-4
Fig. 7-5
2
3
2
3
1
1
Fig. 7-6
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 7 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
(g) The wedge must be assembled correctly.
(Fig. 7-7)
(h) Unscrew the frame clamp lever and pull it
out. (Fig. 7-8)
Fig. 7-7
(i) Loosen and remove the washer, the screws
and the claw. (Fig. 7-9)
(j) Re-assemble the claw on the other side and
reinstall washer, screws and lever. (Fig. 710)
Fig. 7-8
Phillips # 2
Screwdriver
Fig. 7-9
Phillips #2
Screwdriver
Fig. 7-10
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 8 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
(k) Check to make sure that everything is
tightened properly.
(l) Remove Phillips screw and turn the front
wheel holder (strap) 180 degrees. (Fig. 711)
Phillips # 2
Screwdriver
Fig. 7-11
(m) Remove the rear attachment plate by sliding
it forward over the pins on the wheel track
(this will be stiff) and turn it 180 degrees.
(Fig. 7-12)
(n) Re position the attachment plate by sliding
it back over the plastic pins in the profile.
(Fig. 7-13)
Fig.7-12
(o) Slide the rear wheel holder strap and clamp
backward off the wheel track and switch the
sides. (Fig. 7-14)
Fig. 7-13
Fig. 7-14
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 9 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Procedure
(p) Slide the rear wheel holder strap and clamp
back on the wheel track. (Fig. 7-15)
Fig. 7-15
8.
Completing the Installation
(a) Place keys, and DIO installation instructions
in the glove compartment.
Issue: A
04/07/05
Page 10 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4Runner/Highlander/Land Cruiser
2000Rav4/Matrix/Sequoia/Sienna/Tacoma/FJ Cruiser
BIKE RACK
Checklist – these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Rubber Gaskets are properly in place
The Rubber Gaskets should be aligned
within the Adaptors.
within the metal Adaptors.
Adaptors are securely attached to the
Pushing and pulling on the mounted Bike
vehicle Roof Rack.
Rack can not move adaptors.
Front levers are closed properly
Inner lever is locked by locking
mechanism. Both levers aligned against
profile.
The wheel track does not interfere with the
Look between the roof and Bike Rack.
vehicle. Front wheel holder strap is not
hanging down and interfering with the
roof
The bicycle is firmly attached
Issue: A
04/07/05
Make sure that the wheel holders and the
frame holder are firmly attached to the
bike.
Page 11 of 11 pages
DIO
TOYOTA / SCION
ALL
2007 -
FORGED OIL CAP
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Part Number: PTR35-00070
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
Description
Oil Filler Cap w/gasket
TRD Appliqué
Instructions
Item #
1
2
3
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Legend
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
REVISION MARK: This mark highlights a change in
installation with respect to previous issue.
None
Notes
Blankets or covers
Special Tools
Notes
Installation Tools
Notes
Special Chemicals
Notes
Liquid Dish Soap/Water
Solution
Distilled Water
Joy brand or similar
General Applicability
All Toyota and Scion models with screw-in style oil cap
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
Accessory
*Mandatory
Issue: A
09/14/07
Description
Description
Conflicts
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Quantity Reqd.
Page 1 of 5 pages
TOYOTA / SCION ALL
2007 -
FORGED OIL CAP
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Check Box Contents
12 mm Wrench
(a) Check box for contents and/or damage.
2. Vehicle Protection
(a) Open vehicle hood.
(b) Use blankets to protect the front grille area.
3. Removal Procedure: Factory Oil Filler Cap
(a) Remove factory oil filler cap by turning cap
counter-clockwise (Fig. 3-1).
Note: Yaris oil filler cap shown. Other vehicle
models may have oil cap in a different area on
the engine.
(b) Discard factory oil filler cap.
Fig. 3-1
4. Installation Procedure: TRD Oil Filler Cap
(a) Remove TRD appliqué from the top of the
oil filler cap by lifting the piece of tape that
secures the appliqué (Fig. 4-1).
(b) Do not touch top of oil filler cap.
Fig. 4-1
Issue: A
09/14/07
Page 2 of 5 pages
TOYOTA / SCION ALL
2007 -
FORGED OIL CAP
Procedure
(c) Install TRD oil filler cap by turning
clockwise until cap is snug on the engine
(Fig. 4-2).
Fig. 4-2
(d) If necessary, the top of the oil filler cap may
be cleaned by using a lint-free cloth and a
solution of 4 drops Joy liquid dish soap per
cup of water (Fig. 4-3).
(e) Use another lint-free cloth and distilled water
to wipe top of oil filler cap (Fig. 4-3).
(f) Dry top of oil filler cap with a lint-free cloth.
Fig. 4-3
(g) Remove liner paper from back of TRD
appliqué to expose adhesive (Fig. 4-4).
Fig. 4-4
Issue: A
09/14/07
Page 3 of 5 pages
TOYOTA / SCION ALL
2007 -
FORGED OIL CAP
Procedure
(h) Install TRD appliqué on oil filler cap with
TRD logo facing forward (Fig. 4-5).
(1) The TRD logo is correct if it can be read
while standing in front of the vehicle.
(2) Press logo firmly over entire surface to
fully seat adhesive.
Fig. 4-5
(i) Carefully remove the plastic laminate from
the top of the TRD appliqué (Fig. 4-6).
(j) Remove vehicle protection from front of
vehicle.
Fig. 4-6
Issue: A
09/14/07
Page 4 of 5 pages
TOYOTA / SCION ALL
2007 -
FORGED OIL CAP
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Correct TRD logo clocking
TRD logo can be read from front of vehicle
TRD appliqué finish
No plastic laminate covering TRD appliqué
Vehicle Function Checks
Issue: A
09/14/07
Page 5 of 5 pages
TOYOTA
ALL VEHICLES
ALL YEARS
EMERG. ASSIST. KIT
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Part Number: PT420-00045
Kit Contents
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
1
2
1
Description
Emergency Assistance Kit
(EAK)
Tether Strap, Heavy Duty
P/N: PT420-08040
3
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Legend
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Description
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
REVISION MARK: This mark highlights a change in
installation with respect to previous issue.
Conflicts
Note: None
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
None
Special Tools
Notes
None
Installation Tools
Notes
None
Special Chemicals
Notes
None
General Applicability
Note: All Toyota Vehicles
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
Accessory
*Mandatory
Issue: C
01/12/07
Page 1 of 3 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
ALL VEHICLES
ALL YEARS
EMERG. ASSIST. KIT
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
NOTES: “EAK” denotes Emergency Assistance
Kit
1. Install Emergency Assistance Kit.
(A) Cars / SUVs / VAN:
(1) Remove EAK from package.
(2) Place the EAK in the trunk / cargo area of
the vehicle. (Fig. 1-1)
(3) Use included strap to secure EAK to
vehicle trunk / cargo area, as applicable.
Fig. 1-1
(B) Trucks:
(1) Remove EAK from package.
(2) Place EAK on the right front floor of
vehicle. (Fig. 1-2)
(3) The customer may use included strap to
secure to any area of the vehicle, as
applicable.
Fig. 1-2
Issue: C
01/12/07
Page 2 of 3 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
ALL VEHICLES
ALL YEARS
EMERG. ASSIST. KIT
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Confirm secure placement of Emergency
Whenever possible, “Toyota” name is
Assistance Kit.
visible and upright.
Confirm tether strap is tightened and kit is
Loose strap and secure placement.
securely in place.
Vehicle Function Checks
Issue: C
01/12/07
Page 3 of 3 pages
DIO
2005-
4RUNNER
TVIP V2
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR (GBS)
OWNER’S GUIDE
G.B.S. TVIP
(GLASS
SENSOR) ENHANCEMENT
2004-2005 PRIUS
V2BREAKAGE
GLASS BREAKAGE
SENSOR (GBS)
DESIGNED FOR USE WITH YOUR VEHICLE’S
OWNER'S GUIDE
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OWNERS GUIDE
The G.B.S. (GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR) provides protection for your vehicle above and beyond the entry
point monitoring performed by the TDS (Theft Deterrent System)—it “listens” for the noise made by tapping on,
or breaking of glass, and triggers alarms upon detection of these types of noise. Using a microphone designed
VSHFL¿FDOO\IRUWKLVWDVNWKH*%6LVFDSDEOHRILJQRULQJRWKHUQRLVHVZKLFKKHOSVSUHYHQW³IDOVHDODUPV´IURP
occurring. (See reverse for descriptions of alarms.)
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR CHECK PROCEDURE
:KHQWKH*%6ZDVLQVWDOOHGLQ\RXUYHKLFOHFDUHZDVWDNHQWRDGMXVWWKHVHQVLWLYLW\OHYHOSURSHUO\\RXPD\
REVHUYHKRZLWZRUNVIROORZLQJWKHSURFHGXUHOLVWHGEHORZ
1.
Arm the theft deterrent system.
Press the lock button on the remote control or
ORFNWKHGRRUVZLWKWKHNH\ 5HPHPEHUWKHV\VWHPZLOO
not arm if any door, or the trunk, is open.)
:DLWXQWLOWKH6HFXULW\/('VWDUWVÀDVKLQJ
7KH/('ZLOOEHJLQWRÀDVKVHFRQGVDIWHUWKHODVW
door or the trunk is closed.
Please note, your vehicle’s Security LED may look
different than the one pictured here.
:LWKWKHWLSRIDNH\WDSWKHFHQWHURIWKHGULYHU¶V
GRRUZLQGRZ
7DSWKHJODVVZLWKOLJKWWRPRGHUDWHIRUFH
:$51,1* 'RQRWKLWWKHJODVVZLWKH[FHVVLYHIRUFH
HVSHFLDOO\LQFROGZHDWKHURU\RXPD\
crack or break it.
4.
A WARN AWAY ALARM should be triggered. (See re
verse for details.) If the ALARM IS not triggered, make
sure you performed the procedure correctly and try
DJDLQ,IWKHV\VWHPGLGQRWSHUIRUPDV\RXH[SHFWHG
contact your Toyota dealer for more information.
Disarm the theft deterrent system to stop the WARN
AWAY ALARM. Press the unlock button on the
remote control, or use the key to unlock a door, to
disarm the system.
Please note, your remote controls may look different
than the one pictured here.
5HY$
GBS ADD-ON
OWNERS GUIDE
Please note, your remote controls may look different
than the one pictured here.
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM DESCRIPTIONS
WARN-AWAY ALARM
Upon initial detection of noise from tapping on, or breaking glass, the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR triggers a
WARN AWAY ALARM:
7KHKRUQVRXQGVUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHKHDGOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHWDLODQGPDUNHUOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHLQWHULRUOLJKWVWXUQRQIRUVHFRQGV
If the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR detects noise again, or if a door or the trunk is forcibly opened, the regular
DODUP GHVFULEHGEHORZ LVDFWLYDWHG
REGULAR ALARM
:KHQDQDODUPLVWULJJHUHGLQDQ\ZD\RWKHUWKDQLQLWLDOGHWHFWLRQE\WKH*/$66%5($.$*(6(1625WKHIRO
ORZLQJRFFXUV
7KHKRUQVRXQGVUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHKHDGOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHWDLODQGPDUNHUOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHLQWHULRUOLJKWVWXUQRQIRUVHFRQGV
$Q\GRRUORFNZLOOEHUHORFNHGLIVRPHRQHUHDFKHVLQDQGXQORFNVDQLQVLGHORFNEXWWRQ$IWHUVHF
RQGVWKHWKHIWGHWHUUHQWV\VWHPZLOOUHDUPDQGFRQWLQXHWRSURWHFWWKHYHKLFOH
STOPPING AN ALARM
6LPSO\GLVDUPWKHWKHIWGHWHUUHQWV\VWHPXVLQJWKHUHPRWHFRQWURORUNH\DVGHVFULEHGLQWKH2ZQHU¶V*XLGHIRU
your vehicle.
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
HOOD PROTECTOR
Preparation
Part Number: PT427-89060
PT427-8906B
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Kit Contents
General Applicability
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
Description
Hood protector
Hardware bag
Note-
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Quantity Reqd.
4
2
2
4
4
4
6
4
2
2
Description
Outside hood bracket
Grill hood bracket
Grill Hook bracket
6-32 well nut
6-32 x 0.5 MS
#6 SS flat washer
10-24 MS
Mylar pad - small
Double-sided tape
Mylar pad – large
*Mandatory
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Conflicts
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
Vehicle Protection
Blanket
Special Tools
Notes
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Legend
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Accessory
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
None
Installation Tools
Notes
Screwdriver
Ratchet
Phillips, #2
Phillips #2 Bit
Special Chemicals
Notes
Cleaner
Soap and Water
Issue: A
8/14/06
Page 1 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref. #I-1136
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
HOOD PROTECTOR
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Pre-installation Preparation.
(a)
Inspect and verify the kit contents.
(b)
Open the hood.
STOP
(c)
Make sure front edge of hood and grill,
where the deflector is to be installed, is
clean and free from dirt and/or debris
using soap and water.
STOP
(d)
Cover engine bay completely with a
protective blanket to catch any dropped
hardware.
2. Mylar Pad Installation.
(a)
Install the two (2) large mylar pads to
underside of grill. Install the pads third slot
from center on either side. (Fig. 2-1).
(b)
Install four (4) mylar pads to the outer
bracket sections. Align with holes in hood.
(Fig. 2-2).
Fig. 2-1
Fig. 2-2
Issue: A
8/14/06
Page 2 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref. #I-1136
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
HOOD PROTECTOR
Procedure
3. Outer Bracket Installation.
(a)
Install four (4) well nuts into the outer
holes. (Fig. 3-1).
(b)
Install the outside hood brackets in the
locations shown (Fig. 3-2).
(c)
Attach the bracket to the hood using the
6-32 x ½" screw and washer. The washer
goes between the screw head and bracket.
(Fig. 3-2)
Fig. 3-1
Fig. 3-2
4. Grill Bracket Installation
(a) Insert Grill Hook Brackets into the third slot
from center on either side. Make sure
brackets are centered in the slot. (Fig. 4-1)
Fig. 4-1
(b) Apply the double-sided tape to the Grill
Hood Bracket. Remove paper backing from
one side only. Apply this side towards the
bracket, and align pad along top edge and
sides of bracket extension. (Fig. 4-2).
Fig. 4-2
Issue: A
8/14/06
Page 3 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref. #I-1136
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
HOOD PROTECTOR
Procedure
(c) Attach Grill Hood Brackets to the Grill Hook
brackets. Remove paper backing from
double-sided tape and adhere to grill, make
sure the holes in both brackets (grill and
extension) line up. (Fig. 4-3).
Fig. 4-3
5. Install the Shield Assembly to the Vehicle
(a)
Attach shield to grill brackets using two
(2) – ½” (10-24) screws. Hand start the
screws. (Fig. 5-1).
(b)
Peel back protective film from shield in
location where screws attach to brackets.
(c)
Line up shield with the grill brackets
making sure the shield is centered. The
center "V" nib on the inner edge of the
shield should align with the center rib on
the grill (Fig. 5-2).
Fig. 5-1
(d) Line up shield with the outer hood brackets
once again making sure the shield is
centered.
Fig. 5-2
(e) Screw shield to outer brackets using four
(4) 10-24 x ½” screws. Hand start screws
(Fig 5-3).
Fig. 5-3
(f)
Make sure the shield is centered and all six
(6) screws are tight.
(g)
Close the hood.
(h)
Remove entire protective film from shield
and discard film.
Issue: A
8/14/06
Page 4 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref. #I-1136
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
HOOD PROTECTOR
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Inspect brackets
Six brackets installed on hood.
Inspect screws
Six screws installed on hood protector
Screw tightness
Six screws holding hood protector to
brackets are firmly tightened.
Hood closure.
Outside Hood brackets should not contact
the headlights.
Clearance of hood protector to hood.
The hood protector (shield) should not
contact the grill.
Issue: A
8/14/06
Page 5 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref. #I-1136
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Part Number: PTS31-33051
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
1
2
1
Description
Antenna, Interior
Antenna Tape Pad
Wire Harness
Bracket, Floor
Hardware Bags
SIRIUS Satellite Radio
Brochure
Quantity Reqd.
6
7
4
Quantity Reqd.
8
3
Special Chemicals
Notes
Cleaner
VDC approved cleaner and
cleaning method
Note:
Description
Foam Pads
Lock Ties
Double-Sided Tape
Recommended Sequence of Application
Hardware Bag Contents - 2
Item #
1
2
Matt Knife
Metric
6 ¼” Plastic Bondo Spreader
General Applicability
Hardware Bag Contents - 1
Item #
1
2
3
Scissors
Carpet Cutting Knife
Tape Measure
Plastic Spreader
Description
Screw (6-32x5/16)
Nut (Hex 6-32) DO NOT USE
Item #
1
2
3
Accessory
*Mandatory
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
Quantity Reqd.
Item #
1
2
3
Description
Description
Legend
Conflicts
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Notes
Safety Goggles
Seat Covers
Floor Protector
When cutting carpet
Special Tools
Notes
None
Installation Tools
Ratchet
Extension
Sockets
Screwdriver
Nylon Panel
Removal Tool
Low Adhesive Tape
Torque Wrench
Side Cutter
Issue: B
Quantity Reqd.
2/27/06
Notes
10 mm, 14 mm, 8 mm
Phillips, #2
e.g. Panel Pry Tool #1
Toyota SST # 00002-06001-01
50 mm width
Page 1 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
Socket (10 mm), Ratchet
Negative Battery
Cable
1. Vehicle Disassembly.
(a) Set parking brake.
(b) Remove the negative battery cable.
(Fig. 1-1)
(1) Protect the fender before starting.
(2) Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when removing cable.
Fig. 1-1
(c) Disengage the clips and claws and remove
the passenger side door scuff plate.
(Fig. 1-2)
Fig. 1-2
Round Knob
(d) Remove the passenger side cowl side trim as
follows: (Fig. 1-4)
(1) Remove the round knob fastener.
(2) Disengage the 2 claws and then remove.
Fig. 1-3
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 2 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
Screw
(e) Remove the glove box under cover subassembly: (Fig. 1-4)
(1) Remove the screw.
(2) Disengage the 3 clips and remove the
panel.
Fig. 1-4
(f) Remove the glove box. (Fig. 1-5)
(1) Remove the screw from the damper.
(2) Deform the upper part of the glove box to
release the stoppers.
(3) Pull the glove box upward to release 2
claws & remove.
Screw
Fig. 1-5
(g) Remove the glove box finish panel.(Fig. 1-6)
(1) Remove the 4 screws.
(2) Disengage the 2 claws and remove the
panel.
Fig. 1-6
(h) Remove Center Console Upper Rear Panel
Sub-Assembly.
(1) Disengage the 5 clips and 2 claws, and
remove the console upper rear panel, and
then disconnect the connectors. (Fig. 1-7)
Fig. 1-7
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 3 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
(i) Remove Center Console Panel SubAssembly Upper. (Fig. 1-8)
(1) Disengage the 6 clips and 2 claws, and
then remove the console panel subassembly upper.
NOTE: Be careful not to snap the claws during the
operation.
Fig. 1-8
(j) Remove Console Upper Panel Garnish (both
sides). (Fig. 1-9)
(1) Disengage the clip. Pull the console
upper panel garnish rearward to be
removed.
Fig. 1-9
(k) Remove Air Conditioning Control Assembly.
(Fig. 1-10)
(1) Remove the screw.
Screw
Fig. 1-10
(2) Disengage the 4 clips on the control
assembly. (Fig. 1-11)
(3) Disconnect the connectors and then
remove.
Fig. 1-11
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 4 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
(l) Remove driver’s side under dash trim panel.
(Fig. 1-12)
(1) Remove the 2 bolts as shown.
(2) Disengage the 4 claws and remove the
panel.
Fig. 1-12
(m) Remove Instrument Cluster Finish Panel
Sub-Assembly Center. (Fig. 1-13)
(1) Remove the 3 bolts.
(2) Disengage the 8 clips and remove the
instrument cluster finish panel subassembly center.
Fig. 1-13
(n) Prepare Radio Assembly for Removal.
(Fig. 1-14)
(1) Remove the 2 bolts.
2. Remove the “A” Pillar Garnish.
Fig. 1-14
Place mark
here
390mm
Metric Tape Measure
Fig. 2-1
Issue: B
NOTE: Before removing the garnish you must clean
the antenna mounting area with an approved
cleaner and then mark the mounting location of
the tape pad.
2/27/06
(a) Measure from the right side of the tape pad
over to the right side “A” pillar 390mm and
place a mark on the window as shown.
(Fig. 2-1)
Page 5 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
(b) Remove “A” Pillar Garnish.
(1) Using a nylon removal tool, remove the
small covers to access the 2 screws.
(Fig. 2-2)
(2) Remove the 2 screws.
(3) Disengage the 3 clips and remove the
garnish. (Fig. 2-2)
Fig, 3-4
Fig. 2-2
10mm Socket
3. Install the Antenna.
NOTE: Mounting location must be
completely dry & installation temperature
must be between 60° - 100° F before
mounting the tape pad.
(a) Place the pad in the correct mounting
location.
(1) At this point only remove the white
release paper from the mounting pad.
(Fig. 3-1)
Fig. 3-1
Align here
5mm
Gap
(2) When placing the pad on the window,
align the red release paper pull-tab with
approximately 5mm gap from the front of
the headliner and then align with the
mark on the window as shown. (Fig 3-2)
(3) Initially only stick the very top edge of
the tape pad onto the window.
Fig. 3-2
(b) Complete the installation of the tape pad.
(Fig 3-3)
(1) Using a 6 ¼” Plastic Spreader start from
the top of the tape pad and evenly
squeegee down the pad to assure
complete wet-out of the tape.
6 ¼” Plastic Spreader
Fig. 3-3
Issue: B
2/27/06
NOTE: Spreader must completely cover the
width of the tape pad in one downward
stroke in order to assure complete wet-out of
the tape.
Page 6 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
(c) Remove the red release paper from the front
of the antenna tape pad. (Fig. 3-4)
(d) Remove the release tabs from the back of the
antenna, and place the antenna in the proper
position over the mounting pad. (Fig. 3-5)
(1) By hand firmly apply pressure upward on
all 3 corners of the antenna to assure
complete wet-out of the tape pads.
Fig, 3-4
(e) Route the antenna cable up underneath the
front of the headliner as shown. (Fig. 3-5)
Apply pressure
upward on all 3
corners
Fig. 3-5
Note: Must run
antenna cable on
top part of “A”
pillar
3 Foam Tape
Pads
Cable routing
behind dash
(f) Route the cable down the upper part of the
“A” pillar as shown. (Fig. 3-6)
(1) Cut the foam tape pads supplied in kit in
half and place 3 strips along the cable to
hold in position as shown. (Fig. 3-6)
Cable passes
through at bottom
Fig. 3-6
(1) By hand pull down the front of the
headliner and position the antenna cable
up underneath the headliner as shown.
(2) Make sure the cable does not interfere
with the airbag system.
(3) Make sure the cable passes over at the
bottom part of the “A” pillar so it does
not interfere with the airbag system.
(Fig. 3-6)
(g) Continue routing the cable down the
“A” pillar behind the dash as shown.
(Fig. 3-7)
Fig. 3-7
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 7 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
(h) Apply 2 1/3 pieces of foam tape behind the
dash as shown. (Fig. 3-8)
1/3 Foam Tape
Antenna Cable
Fig. 3-8
(i) Continue routing the cable down the “A”
pillar behind the existing wire harness as
shown. (Fig. 3-9)
NOTE: Lock tie will be added when receiver
harness is installed in step 4. (Fig. 3-9)
Lock Tie
Fig. 3-9
(1) Route the cable inside the factory harness
wire clamps along the doorsill. (After the
seat is moved in step 5 the cable will
continue under the carpet to where the
receiver module will be installed.)
(Fig. 3-10)
Antenna Cable
Fig. 3-10
Factory Clips
General routing
behind dash
4. Install and Route the Receiver Harness.
(a) Install and route the receiver harness from
the center cluster and along the front support
bar. (Fig. 4-1)
Fig. 4-1
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 8 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
Harness Routing
(1) Route the receiver harness through the
opening in the glove box behind the cross
member up to the back of the radio.
(Fig. 4-2)
(2) Gently pull out the radio cluster in order
to access the plug-in location and rest on
a support platform to prevent scratching
of dash panels. (Fig. 4-3)
Fig. 4-2
Radio
NOTE: Be careful not to put too much
tension on the radio wire harness when
pulling out the radio.
Support Platform
Fig. 4-3
Lock Tie
(3) Continue pulling the receiver harness
toward the back of the radio. Make sure
you provide sufficient cable slack to
connect to the audio head unit as shown.
Adjust the slack of the cable to match
slack of other cables. (Fig. 4-4)
(4) Install lock tie as shown. (Fig. 4-4)
(5) Connect the receiver harness to the audio
unit. (Fig. 4-5)
NOTE: There already may be a factory
connector in this location. The factory connector
should be removed and plugged into the other
end of the “Y” on the receiver harness. If the
other end of the “Y” is not used lock tie it to
the receiver harness so that it does not rattle.
Fig. 4-4
(6) Place the radio cluster back into position.
12P
Receiver Harness
Fig. 4-5
Issue: B
2/27/06
(7) Be careful not to crimp any of the factory
harnesses or the receiver harness when
replacing the radio.
Page 9 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
Harness
(b) Routing behind the glove box.
(1) Continue routing the receiver harness
behind the main cross member as shown.
(Fig. 4-6)
(2) Place lock tie on metal bracket to secure
receiver harness as shown. (Fig. 4-6)
Lock Tie
Fig. 4-6
Harness
Main
Vehicle
Harness
Lock Tie
(3) Continue routing the harness toward the
“A” pillar bringing it forward crossing
the Main Vehicle Harness as shown.
(Fig. 4-7)
(4) Lock tie to main vehicle harness as
shown. (Fig. 4-7)
Fig. 4-7
(c) Continue routing the harness down the “A”
pillar following where the antenna cable
passes behind the vehicle harnesses.
(Fig. 4-8)
Harness
Lock Tie
(1) Lock Tie to vehicle harness as shown.
(Fig. 4-8)
Fig. 4-8
(d) Cowl Side Wiring
Lock Tie
(2) Cut off excess lock ties with a side cutter.
Fig. 4-9
Issue: B
(1) Continue routing behind the side cowl
trim and secure both the antenna cable
along with the receiver harness to the
vehicle harness with lock tie as shown.
(Fig. 4-9)
2/27/06
Page 10 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
(3) Continue routing the harness through the
door seal through the center of the factory
clips. (After the seat is moved the harness
will continue under the carpet to where
the receiver module will be installed.)
(Fig. 4-10)
Factory Clips
Fig. 4-10
Receiver Harness
5. Access the Receiver Mounting Location.
(a) Protect the center console area before
accessing seat.
(b) Slide the passenger seat forward and remove
the two (2) plastic covers on the seat rails.
Remove the three (2) bolts under the plastic
covers. (Fig. 5-1)
14 mm Socket
Fig. 5-1
14 mm Socket
(c) Slide the seat backwards and remove the two
(2) bolts that hold the front end of the seat
rails. (Fig. 5-2)
(d) Tilt the seat up being careful not to put too
much tension on the wire harness connected
under the seat. (Fig. 5-3)
Bolts x 2
Fig. 5-2
(e) Position the seat so it remains tilted back to
access the receiver mounting area.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the seat or put
too much tension on the seat wire harness when
tilting the seat in the vehicle.
Fig. 5-3
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 11 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
6. Cut Carpet.
(a) Position the metal bracket over the plastic air
vent on the floor under the passenger seat as
shown. (Fig. 6-1) (Seat not shown in picture)
Fig. 6-1
Bracket
Front
(1) Slide the metal bracket over the air vent
under the carpet. (Fig. 6-2)
NOTE: The bracket will be used as a
cutting template when cutting the carpet.
Air Vent under Seat
Fig. 6-2
(b) Using a carpet cutting knife follow the
outside edges of the bracket and cut both
sides of the carpet all the way through to the
end of the bracket as shown. (Fig 6-3 & 6-4)
(1) Make sure there are no wires under the
carpet where the cuts will be made.
Bracket used
as template
Fig. 6-3
Leave flap. Do not
cut back edge
(2) Cut the full length of the bracket.
(3) Do not cut along the back edge. Carpet
will be inserted under the bracket at final
installation. (Fig. 6-4)
Fig. 6-4
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 12 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
7. Install the Receiver.
(a) Remove the bracket from over the air vent
and clean the bracket tape-mounting surface
with an approved cleaner.
(b) Apply 4 pieces of double sided tape onto the
bracket as shown. (Fig. 7-1)
Fig. 7-1
Phillips Screwdriver
NOTE: All tape mounting surfaces must be
completely dry and installation temp
must be between 60° - 100° F.
(c) Install the receiver onto the bracket using the
8 screws supplied in the kit. (Fig. 7-2)
(d) Slide the bracket/receiver assembly over the
air vent and tuck the carpet under the bracket
as shown (Fig. 7-3)
Fig. 7-2
(1) Make sure the bottom of the bracket is
not touching the carpet so it can be
mounted to the floor pan. (Fig. 7-4)
(e) Continue running both the receiver harness
and antenna cable under the carpet to the
receiver unit as shown. (Fig. 7-4 & 7-5)
Fig. 7-3
Connector
Front of
Vehicle
Antenna
Fig. 7-4
Issue: B
2/27/06
Foam
Tape
(1) Make sure the receiver harness goes over
the air vent.
(f) Plug the harness connector and antenna into
the receiver module as shown. (Fig. 7-4)
(1) Tape the antenna cable down to the
bracket with a piece of foam tape as
shown. (Fig. 7-4)
Page 13 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
Coil up &
foam tape
antenna
cable
Fig. 7-5
Bundle &
lock tie
receiver
harness
(2) Bundle up any excess harness and
antenna cable with lock tie and foam tape
and place under the carpet as shown.
(Fig. 7-5)
(g) Clean the floor pan mounting area with an
approved cleaner then remove the 4 release
tabs from the double-sided tape on the
bottom of the bracket and mount the bracket
to the floor pan. (Fig. 7-6)
(1) Make sure the bracket is firmly attached
to the floor pan by firmly applying
pressure down on the receiver/bracket
assembly.
8. Secure Seat Harness.
(a) Seat harness must be slightly moved toward
the center of the vehicle to prevent rubbing
on receiver module.
Fig. 7-6
Metal Bracket
(b) Route as shown & apply lock tie to metal
bracket. (Fig. 8-1)
NOTE: Clip all lock ties before reassembly.
9. Retighten the Radio/Player Head Unit.
(a) Re-install the two (2) screws.
Lock Tie
10. In Process Functional Test.
Move
(a) Temporarily reconnect battery cable.
(b) Turn ignition key to ACC position.
(c) Press the power button on the receiver/player
head unit. Verify the backlighting
illuminates.
Fig. 8-1
(d) Press and release the “SAT” button on the
head unit.
(1) Verify that a satellite channel is received,
or a "NO SIGNAL" message appears on
the display.
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 14 of 16 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Procedure
NOTE: If "ANTENNA" appears (flashing) on
the display - then one or both of the antenna
cables are disconnected from the satellite tuner.
NOTE: If the head unit will not tune or go into
satellite mode - then the tuner cable is
disconnected from the satellite tuner.
(e) Disconnect battery negative cable.
(f) Complete the Reassembly of Vehicle.
11. Complete the Reassembly of the Vehicle:
(a) Re-install the front seat
(1) Reinstall the bolts loosely, and then
tighten them.
(2) Tighten bolts to 37 N-m (27 lbf-ft)
(3) Reconnect any disconnected connectors.
(b) Reinstall glove box.
Socket (10 mm), Ratchet
Negative Battery
Cable
(c) Reinstall upper console panel.
(1) Reconnect any disconnected connectors.
(d) Reinstall lower console panel.
(1) Reconnect the lighter connector and clip.
(e) Reinstall doorsill.
(f) Reconnect the vehicle’s negative battery
cable. (Fig. 10-1)
Fig. 10-1
(1) Reconnect the negative terminal to
factory original position.
(2) Tighten the nut with 4.1 N-m (36 lbf-in)
of torque.
(3) Be careful not to touch the positive
battery terminal.
(g) Clean up and remove any trash.
(h) Place the owner "SIRIUS Satellite Radio"
brochure in the glove box.
Issue: B
2/27/06
Page 15 of 16 pages
LEXUS
4RUNNER
2006 - SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Accessory Function Checks
Look For:
Satellite Radio Tuner
*Verify the proper operation of the Satellite
Radio Tuner.
Receiver/player Assembly
*Verify the proper operation of the
Receiver/player Assembly
*Verify both AM & FM have good
reception.
*(Refer to the receiver assembly and radio
owner’s manuals.)
Vehicle Function Checks
Hazard switch
Proper operation of the hazard switch
Navigation System (if equipped)
Functioning NAV System
HVAC
Proper operation of the air conditioning
system
Multi-information displays.(Clock, Temp.,
Verify the proper operation of the multi-
and MPG meter)
information displays.
Operation of the L&R seat heater switch
Verify the proper operation of the L&R seat
heater switch.
Operation of the 12V outlet switch
Verify the proper operation of the 12V
outlet switch.
Issue: B
Refer to your Auto Repair Manual, and
return the electric Moon Roof to its initial
position.
Electric Moon Roof Auto-open and Autoclose functions operate correctly.
4wd Switch if applicable)
Functioning
Suspension Control Switch
Functioning
2/27/06
Page 16 of 16 pages
2003 4 RUNNER
TVIP V5
RS3200 PLUS
OWNER’S GUIDE
RS3200 PLUS
SECURITY SYSTEM
DESIGNED FOR USE WITH YOUR VEHICLE’S
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM
OWNER’S GUIDE
Rev. A 09/24/02
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 1
To better understand the features and functions of this security system, please read this Owner’s
Guide completely prior to use.
For
N
m
d
ock
r
on
w
TABLE OF CONTENTS
DESCRIPTION
INTRODUCTION
BRIEF DESCRIPTION–RS3200 PLUS FEATURES
OPERATION
ARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE ARMING)
DISARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE DISARMING)
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC) ARMING & DISARMING
AUTOMATIC REARMING
ARMING SUSPENSION
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM TRIGGERS
ALARM DESCRIPTIONS
STOPPING AN ALARM
PAGE
2
3, 4
5
6
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR INFORMATION
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR CHECK PROCEDURE
11
PROGRAMMING
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC) ARMING AND ENTRY DELAY
(Not applicable to Highlander and Sienna. Please consult your
Toyota Dealer for programming information.)
WARNING and CAUTION INFORMATION
12
13
Page 2
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
INTRODUCTION
GLASS BREAKA
Congratulations on your choice of the RS3200 PLUS add-on security system to protect your vehicle!
To get the most from the system, we strongly recommend that you read this Owner’s Guide completely to learn all of its features and functions.
The RS3200 PLUS provides security through point-of-entry monitoring, glass breakage detection and
ignition switch monitoring. While ARMED, the system will be TRIGGERED and sound an ALARM when a
door, trunk or hatch is forcibly unlocked or opened*, or when a window is tapped on or broken.
During the ALARM, the vehicle’s horn sounds and the headlights, tail lights and front marker or turn
signal lights flash. A l s o , the vehicle’s starter is disabled, preventing engine start. In addition to the
comprehensive protection, the RS3200 PLUS works in conjunction with your vehicle’s remote keyless entry system, enabling you to ARM and DISARM the security system at the same time the doors
are remotely locked and unlocked. In vehicles equipped with a buzzer, it will chirp when the system
is REMOTE ARMED and DISARMED.
The RS3200 PLUS provides pro
“listens” for the noise made by
specifically for this task, the GL
helps to prevent “false alarms”
GLASS BREAKAGE SE
When the RS3200 PLUS was in
of the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSO
below.
1.
An important note about your system
➀➁
Throughout this guide, there are references to the STATUS MONITOR for this system. Illustrated
below, this panel holds the LED indicator (for the system’s operating status) and the GLASS
BREAKAGE SENSOR’S microphone. In vehicles equipped with an engine immobilizer system, there is
a LED already installed, so the RS3200 PLUS utilizes the vehicle’s engine immobilizer system LED➂
instead and a microphone mounted in a separate location. If your vehicle falls into this category,
remember to look at that LED when the information refers to the STATUS MONITOR. If you do not
know where the LED is located, refer to your vehicle’s owner’s guide for specific information.
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PREARMING)
THEN
STARTS
FLASHING
(SYSTEM
IS
ARMED)
➁
2.
➂
YOUR ENGINE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM LED MAY LOOK
DIFFERENT THAN THE ONE
ILLUSTRATED HERE
3.
* When the system is PASSIVELY (AUTOMATICALLY) ARMED, there is an ENTRY DELAY that will elapse
when a door is opened before an ALARM is TRIGGERED.
4.
OR,
H
S
tem
GH
S
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 3
BRIEF DESCRIPTION–RS3200 PLUS FEATURES
FEATURES
FUNCTIONS
The RS3200 PLUS will ARM 30 seconds after the lock button on the remote
REMOTE
keyless entry system’s remote control is pressed, and DISARM when the
ARMING/DISARMING
unlock button is pressed. If your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer that chirps
when the lock and unlock buttons on the remote controls are pressed, the
buzzer will also chirp when the system is REMOTE ARMED and DISARMED.
The RS3200 PLUS will automatically REARM at the same time the
AUTOMATIC
vehicle’s remote keyless entry system relocks the vehicle’s
REARMING
doors, if no door is opened within 30 seconds after REMOTE DISARMING.
The RS3200 PLUS will ARM 30 seconds after you close the trunk (if
KEY
open) and lock the vehicle’s doors with the key, and will DISARM when
ARMING/DISARMING
you unlock a door with the key.
While ARMED, the trunk may be opened with the key (or trunk release button
ARMED MODE
SUSPENSION**
on your remote control, if so equipped) without TRIGGERING an ALARM. Once
the open trunk is closed, the system ARMS again.
The RS3200 PLUS may be programmed to automatically ARM 30
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC)
seconds
after the ignition key is removed, the vehicle exited and the
ARMING
last door and the trunk closed, without the necessity of locking doors.
The RS3200 PLUS may be DISARMED with the vehicle’s ignition key
PASSIVE DISARMING
after it was PASSIVELY ARMED.
ADJUSTABLE ENTRY
When the RS3200 PLUS has been PASSIVELY ARMED, an ENTRY DELAY
DELAY
(user-selectable at 0, 15, or 30 seconds) will start when a door is
opened before an ALARM is TRIGGERED.
When you lock the vehicle with the central lock switch (while a door
MANUAL ARMING
is open), the RS3200 PLUS will ARM 30 seconds after you close all
the doors and the trunk (if open).
The RS3200 PLUS may be DISARMED by inserting the key into the
IGNITION KEY
ignition switch and turning it to “ON.”
DISARMING
Forcibly unlocking or opening a door or trunk while the RS3200 PLUS
POINT-OF-ENTRY
is ARMED will TRIGGER an ALARM immediately. (If the system was PASSIVELY
PROTECTION
ARMED, the ENTRY DELAY must pass after opening a door before the ALARM is
TRIGGERED.)
The RS3200 PLUS utilizes a microphone (usually mounted in the
GLASS BREAKAGE
STATUS MONITOR) to sense the noise from tapping on window glass, or
SENSOR
glass breaking, and TRIGGER the system to sound an ALARM. It is fine
tuned to “listen” for this type of noise, and ignore other sounds.
WARN AWAY ALARM
When the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR’S microphone picks up tapping or
breaking of window glass, it TRIGGERS a WARN AWAY ALARM; the headlights
and tail and marker or turn signal lights flash, and the horn sounds for 20
seconds, but the starter is not disabled. If there is another detection of glass
tapping or breaking, or if a door is opened or unlocked without a key, the
regular ALARM is TRIGGERED.
While ARMED, the RS3200 PLUS monitors the ignition switch. If an attempt is
IGNITION SWITCH
made to start the vehicle without a key, an ALARM is TRIGGERED.
MONITORING
**Starting from 2002 M.Y., Arming Suspension Mode by using the key to unlock the trunk is not applicable
to Camry, Solara, and Corolla.
Page 4
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
BRIEF DESCRIPTION–RS3200 PLUS FEATURES
FEATURES
FUNCTIONS
When an ALARM is TRIGGERED, the system disables the vehicle’s
starter and prevents engine start until the system is reset (DISARMED).
During an ALARM, the system will lock the doors if one is unlocked,
FORCED LOCK
and
will continue to do so for the duration of the ALARM.
DURING ALARM
The user is notified that an ALARM occurred. Upon DISARMING the
TRIGGER MEMORY *
system after an ALARM was TRIGGERED, the vehicle’s tail and marker lights
will be turned on for 2 seconds.
The RS3200 PLUS flashes the vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights
EXTERIOR LIGHT
during REMOTE ARMING and REMOTE DISARMING, and during an ALARM.
ACTIVATION
Also, during an ALARM the headlights flash.
If
your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer that chirps when the lock
BUZZER ACTIVATION
and unlock buttons on the remote keyless entry system’s remote
controls are pressed, the buzzer will also chirp when the system is
REMOTE ARMED and DISARMED.
HORN ACTIVATION
During an ALARM, the RS3200 PLUS activates the vehicle’s horn.
If power to the RS3200 PLUS is disrupted while it is ARMED, an ALARM is
POWER LOSS MEMORY
TRIGGERED once power is restored.
This
panel houses the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR microphone and the
STATUS MONITOR
flashing LED that indicates the operating status of the security system.
(Some vehicle applications utilize the vehicle’s engine immobilizer system
LED and a separate microphone, instead.)
STARTER DISABLE
ALARM INFORMA
ALARM TRIGGERS
While the system is ARMED, an
➤
F
P
a
➤
M
M
N
➤
“
T
t
* TRIGGER MEMORY is not available for Corolla / Matrix.
➤
T
T
A
h
➤
P
I
A
e
em
LL
R 30
S
HEN
THE
RMED
TOYOTA RS3000 PLUS Security system
Page 5
OPERATION
ARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE ARMING)
The system may be ARMED in several ways. Do one of the following:
Lock the doors with your key:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors.*
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary.*
Insert the key into the door key switch and turn it toward the
front of the vehicle:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀ The system is now ARMED.
TURN TOWARD THE
FRONT
OF THE VEHICLE
Lock the doors from inside the vehicle:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Open the driver’s or front passenger’s door.
Push the central lock switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors.*
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary.* Then:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀ The system is now ARMED.
PUSH THE LOCK
SWITCH WHILE THE
and
sing
R’S
Lock the doors with the remote control:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors.*
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary.*
Press the lock button on the remote control. Simultaneously:
The doors lock.➁
The vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights flash
once.③
The vehicle’s buzzer chirps once.∆
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀ The system is now ARMED.
PRESS AND RELEASE
THE LOCK BUTTON
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PREARMING)
THEN
FLASHES
(SYSTEM
IS
ARMED)
➁
ALL DOORS LOCK WHEN
THE SYSTEM IS REMOTE
ARMED
③
THE TAIL AND MARKER OR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHTS FLASH ONCE WHEN THE SYSTEM IS
REMOTE ARMED
* The system will not ARM while any of the doors, trunk or hatch is open.
∆ If your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer.
Page 6
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
OPERATION
OPERATION
DISARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE DISARMING)
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC)
The system may be DISARMED in several ways. Do one of the following:
When the RS3200 PLUS is prog
is removed and all doors and th
come back to your vehicle and
it to “ON” during the ENTRY DEL
the doors, regular ARMING will o
PROGRAMMING information o
the ENTRY DELAY time. (Not a
Deale
Unlock the doors with your key:
Insert the key into the door key switch and turn it toward the rear of
the vehicle:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED stops flashing.➀The system is
now DISARMED.*
TURN TOWARD THE
REAR
OF THE VEHICLE
In the case of Highlander, Sienna, and 4Runner, you may also disarm
the system using the key in the back door; all doors will unlock at the
same time.
Unlock the doors with the remote control:
Press the unlock button on the remote control. Simultaneously:
The driver’s door unlocks.➁
The vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights flash
twice.➂
The vehicle’s buzzer chirps twice.∆
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED stops flashing.➀The system is
now DISARMED.*
Press the unlock button again within 3 seconds after unlocking the
driver’s door to unlock the remaining doors.
PUSH THE UNLOCK
BUTTON
Use the ignition switch:
Insert the key into the ignition switch, then turn it to ON.
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED stops flashing.➀The system is
now DISARMED.*
TURN THE KEY TO “ON”
TO
DISARM THE SYSTEM
This method of disarming is rarely used. You must be inside the
vehicle while the system is armed in order to do it.
NOTE: If your vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights turn on for 2 seconds when the system
is DISARMED,* the TRIGGER MEMORY was activated; something TRIGGERED an ALARM while
you were away from the vehicle. This feature is not available for Corolla / Matrix.
➀
➁
STOPS
FLASHING
WHEN
THE SYSTEM IS
DISARMED
THE DRIVER’S DOOR
UNLOCKS WHEN THE
SYSTEM IS REMOTE
DISARMED
➂
THE TAIL AND MARKER OR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHTS FLASH TWICE WHEN THE SYSTEM
IS REMOTE DISARMED
* Please note, if the system utilizes your vehicle’s engine immobilizer system LED instead of the
STATUS MONITOR, the LED will continue to flash.
∆ If your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer.
T
R
E
A
C
w
A
THE SYSTEM ARMS 30
SECONDS AFTER THE
LAST ENTRY POINT (DOOR,
TRUNK OR HATCH)
IS CLOSED
T
E
T
I
b
THE SYSTEM DISARMS
WHEN
YOU INSERT THE KEY
AND TURN IT TO “ON”
Y
d
NOTE: If your vehicle’s tail an
is turned to “ON”, the
while you were away f
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PRE-ARMING)
THEN
STARTS
FLASHING
(SYSTEM
IS ARMED)
➁
* If the ENTRY DELAY time elap
TRIGGERED. To DISARM the sy
press and release the remote
of
m is
sarm
the
m is
e
m is
em
e
AL
EM
e
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 7
OPERATION
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC) ARMING & DISARMING
When the RS3200 PLUS is programmed to PASSIVELY ARM, the system will ARM after the ignition key
is removed and all doors and the trunk are closed; you do not need to lock the doors. When you
come back to your vehicle and open a door, you must insert the key into the ignition switch and turn
it to “ON” during the ENTRY DELAY (0, 15 or 30 seconds), or an ALARM will be TRIGGERED. If you lock
the doors, regular ARMING will override PASSIVE ARMING; there will be no ENTRY DELAY. See the
PROGRAMMING information on page 13 to activate the PASSIVE ARMING mode, as well as to select
the ENTRY DELAY time. (Not applicable to Highlander and Sienna. Please consult your Toyota
Dealer for programming information .)
THE SYSTEM ARMS 30
SECONDS AFTER THE
LAST ENTRY POINT (DOOR,
TRUNK OR HATCH)
IS CLOSED
THE SYSTEM DISARMS
WHEN
YOU INSERT THE KEY
AND TURN IT TO “ON”
To PASSIVELY ARM the system:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors. (The system will not
ARM while any of the doors are open.)
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary. (The system will not ARM
while the trunk or hatch is open.)
After the last door, trunk or hatch is closed:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀The system is now ARMED.
To DISARM the PASSIVELY ARMED system:
Enter the vehicle through a front door.
The ENTRY DELAY begins:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on (no flashing.)➁
Insert the key into the ignition switch and turn it to “ON”
before the ENTRY DELAY ends.*
The LED turns off. The system is now DISARMED.
You may also DISARM the system following any of the methods
described on page 6.
NOTE: If your vehicle’s tail and marker lights turn on for 2 seconds when the ignition key
is turned to “ON”, the TRIGGER MEMORY was activated; something TRIGGERED an ALARM
while you were away from the vehicle. This feature is not available for Corolla/Matrix.
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PRE-ARMING)
THEN
STARTS
FLASHING
(SYSTEM
IS ARMED)
➁
TURNS
ON (NO
FLASHING)
DURING
THE
ENTRY
DELAY
* If the ENTRY DELAY time elapses before the ignition switch is turned to “ON”, an ALARM will be
TRIGGERED. To DISARM the system during an ALARM, insert the ignition key and turn it to “ON”, or
press and release the remote control’s unlock button.
Page 8
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
OPERATION
OPERATION
AUTOMATIC REARMING
ARMING THE RS3200 P
When you unlock the doors using the remote control, the RS3200 PLUS is DISARMED at the same
time. However, if you do not open a door or the trunk within 30 seconds, the keyless entry system
will relock the doors and the RS3200 PLUS will REARM 30 seconds later.
The system may be ARMED in s
L
R
E
C
I
f
How the RS3200 PLUS automatically REARMS:
0
45
TURN TOWARD THE
FRONT
OF THE VEHICLE
15
30
THE DOORS ARE
UNLOCKED BY
PRESSING THE
UNLOCK BUTTON
ON THE REMOTE
CONTROL...
WHEN NO DOOR,
TRUNK OR HATCH
IS OPENED...
FOR MORE THAN
30
SECONDS...
ARMING SUSPENSION**
THE LED WILL
THE KEYLESS
ENTRY
LIGHT UP FOR 30
SYSTEM AUTOMATSECONDS
(PRE-ARM), THEN
ICALLY RELOCKS
THE DOORS, THEN FLASH WHEN THE
THE RS3200 PLUS SYSTEM IS ARMED
AUTOMATICALLY
REARMS.
L
R
O
P
E
C
PUSH THE LOCK
SWITCH WHILE THE
The ARMED state of the RS3200 PLUS can be suspended temporarily by using the key to unlock and
open the trunk. If your remote control is so equipped, you may also suspend the ARMED state using
the trunk release button➀to open the trunk. When the ARMING is suspended, the STATUS MONITOR’S
LED will turn off ➁until the trunk is closed again.
➀
OPENING THE TRUNK
SUSPENDS THE
ARMED STATE OF THE
SECURITY SYSTEM
L
R
E
C
P
➁
TURNS
OFF
WHEN
THE
ARMED
STATE
IS SUSPENDED
**Starting from 2002 M.Y., Arming
Suspension Mode by using the
key to unlock the trunk is not
applicable to Camry, Solara, and
Corolla.
PRESS AND RELEASE
THE LOCK BUTTON
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PREARMING)
THEN
FLASHES
(SYSTEM
IS
ARMED)
➁
ALL
THE
* The system will not ARM whil
∆ If your vehicle is equipped w
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 9
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM TRIGGERS
While the system is ARMED, an ALARM will be TRIGGERED when any of the following occurs:
➤
Forcibly opening a door, or the trunk or hatch without a key
Pulling the trunk release lever inside the vehicle will also TRIGGER
an ALARM.
s
ts
m
➤
Manually unlocking a door
Manually operating an inside lock button will TRIGGER an ALARM.
Note: Because this action will TRIGGER an ALARM, it is important
that you do not ARM the system while someone is in the
vehicle.
➤
“Hot wiring” the vehicle
The RS3200 PLUS can detect the absence of the ignition key if
the ignition circuit is shorted in attempt to start the vehicle.
➤
Tapping on or breaking the glass
The noise from tapping on, or breaking of glass TRIGGERS a WARN
AWAY ALARM first, then a regular ALARM. See the description of
how the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR TRIGGERS ALARMS on page 12.
➤
Power restoration
If power to the system is interrupted while it is ARMED, an
ALARM will be TRIGGERED immediately when power is restored.
TOYOTA RS3000 PLUS Security system
Page 10
BRIEF DESCRIP
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM DESCRIPTIONS
FEATURES
Regular ALARM ➀
When an ALARM is triggered in any way other than initial detection by the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR,
the following occur:
The horn sounds repeatedly for 60 seconds.
The headlights flash repeatedly for 60 seconds.
The tail and marker or turn signal lights flash repeatedly for 60 seconds.
The starter is disabled (no engine start) until the system is DISARMED.
The door lock will be relocked if someone reaches in and unlocks the inside lock button.
After 60 seconds of ALARM, the system will REARM and continue to protect the vehicle.
➀
THE HORN
SOUNDS
FOR 60 SECONDS
THE STARTER IS DISABLED UNTIL THE SYSTEM
IS DISARMED
TAIL OR TURN SIGNAL LIGHTS FLASH
FOR 60 SECONDS
MARKER OR TURN
SIGNAL LIGHTS
FLASH
FOR 60 SECONDS
HEAD LIGHTS
FLASH
FOR 60 SECONDS
WARN-AWAY ALARM ➁
Upon initial detection of noise from tapping on, or breaking glass, the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR
TRIGGERS a WARN AWAY ALARM:
The horn sounds repeatedly for 20 seconds.
The headlights flash repeatedly for 20 seconds.
The tail and marker or turn signal lights flash repeatedly for 20 seconds.
If the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR detects noise again, or if a door or trunk is opened while the system
is still ARMED, the regular ALARM (described above) is activated.
➁
THE HORN
SOUNDS
FOR 20 SECONDS
TAIL OR TURN SIGNAL LIGHTS FLASH
FOR 20 SECONDS
HEADLIGHTS FLASH
FOR 20 SECONDS MARKER OR TURN
SIGNAL LIGHTS FLASH
FOR 20 SECONDS
STOPPING AN ALARM
Simply DISARM the system using the remote control or key as described on page 6.
Th
ke
un
wh
bu
Th
AUTOMATIC
ve
REARMING
do
Th
KEY
op
ARMING/DISARMING
yo
W
ARMED MODE
SUSPENSION**
on
th
Th
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC)
se
ARMING
la
Th
PASSIVE DISARMING
af
ADJUSTABLE ENTRY
W
DELAY
(u
op
W
MANUAL ARMING
is
th
Th
IGNITION KEY
ig
DISARMING
Fo
POINT-OF-ENTRY
is
PROTECTION
AR
TR
Th
GLASS BREAKAGE
ST
SENSOR
gl
tu
WARN AWAY ALARM
W
br
an
se
ta
re
W
IGNITION SWITCH
m
MONITORING
REMOTE
ARMING/DISARMING
**Starting from 2002 M.Y., Armin
to Camry, Solara, and Corolla
cle!
-
and
na
n
he
ors
em
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 11
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR INFORMATION
The RS3200 PLUS provides protection for your vehicle above and beyond entry point monitoring–it
“listens” for the noise made by tapping on, or breaking of glass. Using a microphone designed
specifically for this task, the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR is capable of ignoring other noises, which
helps to prevent “false alarms” from occurring.
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR CHECK PROCEDURE
When the RS3200 PLUS was installed in your vehicle, care was taken to adjust the sensitivity level
of the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR. You may observe how it works following the procedure listed
below.
1.
ARM the system.
Press the lock button on the remote control or lock the doors
with the key.
(Remember, the system will not ARM if any door, the trunk or
hatch is open.)
is
D➂
2.
Wait until the STATUS MONITOR’S LED starts flashing.
The LED will flash 30 seconds after the last door, the trunk or
hatch is closed.
3.
With the tip of a key, tap the center of the driver’s door window.
Tap the glass with light to moderate force.
WARNING: Do not hit the glass with excessive force, especially
in cold weather, or you may crack or break it.
A WARN AWAY ALARM should be TRIGGERED. If the ALARM is not
TRIGGERED, make sure you performed the procedure correctly
and try again. If you find that the system did not perform as
expected, contact your Toyota dealer for more information.
se
4.
DISARM the system to stop the WARN AWAY ALARM.
Press the unlock button on the remote control or use the key
to DISARM the system.
Page 12
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
PROGRAMMING
The RS3200 PLUS is factory-set to not PASSIVELY ARM. To change the system’s operation for
PASSIVE ARMING operation, as well as adjust the ENTRY DELAY time, follow the procedure below. For
more information on this feature, please refer to page 7. (Not applicable to Highlander and
Sienna. Please consult your Toyota Dealer for programming information.)
PASSIVE ARMING ON/OFF SELECTION, ENTRY DELAY TIME SELECTION
1.
Before you begin:
Open the driver’s door. Close the remaining doors
and the trunk or hatch. Unlock all doors with the inside
lock switch. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
2.
Insert and remove the key from
the ignition key cylinder 3
times; this must be completed
within 5 seconds.
Start the Programming Procedure. (Complete these steps within 40 seconds.)
To better understand the featu
Guide completely prior to use.
TABLE OF CONT
INTRODUCTION
BRIEF DESCRIPTIO
OPERATION
ARMING THE RS
DISARMING THE
PASSIVE (AUTOM
AUTOMATIC REA
ARMING SUSPEN
ALARM INFORMATIO
a. Close the driver’s
door.
b. Lock and unlock all
doors 3 times by key
or remote control.
c.
Open and close
the driver’s door.
d. Lock, then unlock
the driver’s door
inside lock button
3 times.
ALARM TRIGGER
ALARM DESCRIP
STOPPING AN AL
GLASS BREAKAGE
GLASS BREAKAG
PROGRAMMING
PASSIVE (AUTOM
(Not applicable to
Toyota Dealer for
e. Open the driver’s
door.
3.
f.
The system locks the door
in 2 seconds; if this does
not happen, start over.
g. Unlock the driver’s
door knob.
Select the Operating Mode and Complete the Programming Procedure.
a. Close, then Open the driver’s door: b. Lock then unlock the
2 times = PASSIVE ARMING OFF
driver’s door inside lock
3 times = PASSIVE ARMING ON,
button 1 time.
0 Sec. ENTRY DELAY
4 times = PASSIVE ARMING ON,
15 Sec. ENTRY DELAY
5 times = PASSIVE ARMING ON,
30 Sec. ENTRY DELAY
c.
The system locks the
door in 2 seconds; if this
does not happen, start
over. Programming is now
complete.
WARNING and CAUT
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 13
Warning
•
This product is applicable only to vehicles with 12V DC, negative grounding specifications. Do
not use in vehicles with 24V specifications. Otherwise, damage to the unit or a fire may result.
•
Never attempt to disassemble or modify the product. Otherwise, an accident, fire or electric
shock may result.
•
When replacing fuses, be sure to use fuses with the same specified capacity (amperage.)
Otherwise, damage to the unit or vehicle, fire or electric shock may result.
•
If an abnormal condition occurs, such as liquids spilling onto the product, or the product
emitting smoke or strange odors, stop using it immediately and consult the dealer from whom
you purchased the product. Continued use of the product before corrective actions are taken
may result in an accident, injury or fire.
•
Never pull the plastic bag over your head. Otherwise, a serious injury or death from suffocation
may occur.
Caution
•
Do not use this product for applications other than in-vehicle use. Otherwise, an electric shock
or injury may result.
•
Do not allow children to play with the remote controls. Otherwise, the doors may be locked or
unlocked, the security system armed or disarmed, or an alarm triggered unintentionally.
•
If this product is dropped or its case is damaged, disconnect the power supply lead and
contact the dealer from whom you purchased it to obtain service. Otherwise, a fire or electric
shock may result.
RS3
SECURI
DESIGN
REMOT
OWN
090002-25520700
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200 PLUS)
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Part Number: 08586-3D871
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
1
1
1
Description
Wire Harness
V5 Security ECU
ECU Mounting Bracket
GBS ECU
GBS ECU Mounting Bracket
Microphone
Torque Wrench
Pliers
Pliers
Pneumatic/Electric Wrench
4.1 N·m (36 lbf·in)
Slip-joint
Needle Nose
Special Chemicals
Notes
Cleaner
Glass Cleaner
3MTM Prep Solvent-70
Household Windex
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Quantity Reqd.
15
5
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
General Applicability
Description
Medium Wire Ties
Large Wire Ties
Small Foam Tape Strip
Large Foam Tape Strip
Splicing Connector
Bolt
Nut
Butyl Tape
Key Tag
Warning Label
Owner’s Guide
Warranty Card
Note: 4Runner with factory keyless entry, only.
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
*Mandatory
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Item #
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Conflicts
Note: Must not be installed in vehicles with factory TDS.
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
Safety Glasses
Safety Gloves
Vehicle Protection
(Optional)
Blankets, Part Boxes
Special Tools
Notes
Striker Tool
CAD-E IADE P/N
ALL 02-016-01
Installation Tools
Notes
Phillips Head Screwdriver
Flat Blade Screwdriver
Socket
Socket Extension
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
#2, screwdriver or tip
Small, Flat Blade
10mm
3"
e.g. Panel Pry Tool #1
Issue: B
04/22/05
Description
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
REVISION MARK: This mark highlights a change in
installation with respect to previous issue.
Toyota SST # 00002-06001-01
Wrench
Side Cutters
Quantity Reqd.
Legend
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Accessory
V5
Audio
10mm
Page 1 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:x Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
x Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
x Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
x Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Vehicle Disassembly.
(a) Remove the negative battery cable. (Fig. 1-1)
10mm Wrench
Negative Battery
Cable
(1) Protect the fender before starting.
(2) For automatic equipped vehicles, place
the shifter in low gear and set the parking
brake prior to disconnecting the battery.
(3) Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when removing cable.
Fig. 1-1
(b) Remove the passenger side step cover.
(Fig. 1-2)
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
(1) Cover the floor and seats before starting.
(c) Remove the passenger side cowl cover.
(Fig. 1-3)
(1) Remove the nut securing the cover.
Step Cover
Fig. 1-2
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
Nut
Cowl Cover
Fig. 1-3
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 2 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
(d) Remove the glove box assembly. (Fig. 1-4)
(1) Remove the screw securing the glove box
assembly.
(2) Remove the glove box damper.
Damper
Screw
(1) Remove the four screws securing the
cover.
Glove Box
Fig. 1-4
(e) Remove the cover from the upper glove box
area. (Fig. 1-5)
(2) Remove the air bag connector holder
from the cover.
10mm Wrench
Cover
Screws (x2)
Screws
(x2)
(f) Remove the under-dash cover below the
glove box area. (Fig. 1-6)
(1) Remove the one screw.
(2) Disconnect the two connectors on the
4WD control ECU (if equipped), and
remove the one vehicle wire harness clip.
Air Bag Connector
Fig. 1-5
2. V5 Wire Harness Installation.
(a) Prepare a protective sheet (blanket), and
cover the blower assembly in the glove box
area with the sheet as shown. (Fig. 2-1)
Under-Dash Cover
Screw
Fig. 1-6
Protective Sheet
Fig. 2-1
Issue: B
Clip
04/22/05
Page 3 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
4P (White)
(b) Locate the vehicle harness’ white 4P
connector from the glove box area. (Fig. 2-2)
4P (White)
V5 Harness
(c) Plug in the V5 harness’ white 4P connector
to the vehicle harness’ white 4P connector.
(Fig. 2-2)
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
(d) Locate and disconnect the white 13P
connector from the connector block in the
glove box area. Plug in the V5 harness’ white
13P connectors between the vehicle harness’
white 13P connector and the connector
block. (Fig. 2-3)
Fig. 2-2
13P (White)
V5 Harness
Fig. 2-3
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
(e) Wrap the white 4P connectors with one large
strip of foam tape. (Fig. 2-4)
13P (White)
(f) Wrap the white 13P connectors, V5 harness
and vehicle harness with one large strip of
foam tape. (Fig. 2-4)
Side Cutter
Medium Wire
Ties (x2)
Relay
13P
Large Wire
Ties (x2)
Fig. 2-4
Large Foam Tapes (x3)
(h) Secure the V5 harness relay to the vehicle
harness with one large wire tie. (Fig. 2-4)
4P
(i) Secure the 4P connectors to the vehicle
harness with one large wire tie. (Fig.2-4)
10mm Socket
V5 Harness
Existing
Bolt
(g) Wrap the V5 harness relay with one large
strip of foam tape. (Fig. 2-4)
(j) Secure the V5 harness to the vehicle harness
with two medium wire ties. (Fig.2-4)
(k) Locate and remove the existing bolt from the
ground point in the passenger-side cowl area.
(Fig. 2-5)
Fig. 2-5
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 4 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
Side Cutter
V5 Harness
(l) Secure the V5 harness ground wire terminal,
along with the vehicle harness ground wire
terminal, using the existing bolt. (Fig. 2-6)
(1) Use the vehicle’s ground bolt to secure
the V5 harness ground wire.
Existing Bolt
Medium Wire
Ties (x2)
(2) Verify the bolt is tight.
(m)Secure the V5 harness with two medium wire
ties. (Fig. 2-6)
Fig. 2-6
(n) Route the V5 harness toward the upper glove
box area, and secure it to the vehicle harness
with two medium wire ties. (Fig. 2-7)
Side Cutter
(o) Route the V5 harness toward the left side of
the glove box area, and secure it to the
vehicle harness with one medium wire tie
and the existing vehicle wire clip. (Fig. 2-8)
Medium Wire
Ties (x2)
V5 Harness
Fig. 2-7
Side Cutter, Pliers
(1) Remove the vehicle wire clip on the
center brace and open the vehicle wire
clip.
(2) Route the V5 wire harness though the
open vehicle wire clip.
Medium Wire Tie
Wire Clip
(3) Close and reinstall the vehicle wire clip
to the brace.
(p) Locate the vehicle harness’ white 40P
connector in the upper left side of the glove
box area. (Fig. 2-9)
V5 Harness
Fig. 2-8
(1) Remove the adjacent vehicle wire clip
and tape to loosen the 40P connector.
Pliers
(2) Reinstall the vehicle wire clip without the
40P connector.
Tape
Wire Clip
40P (White)
Fig. 2-9
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 5 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
V5 Harness’ GREEN/RED
and GRAY/GREEN Wires
(r) Locate the wire on the white 40P connector
(top row, sixteenth space from the left) and
attach the V5 harness’ GREEN/RED wire
with a splicing connector. Then locate the
wire on the bottom row (sixteenth space from
the left) and attach the V5 harness’
GRAY/GREEN wire with a splicing
connector. (Fig. 2-11)
Fig. 2-10
Side Cutter, Slip-joint Pliers
30mm
GREEN/RED
40P (White)
GRAY/GREEN
Fig. 2-11
(q) Route the V5 harness’ GREEN/RED and
GRAY/GREEN wires inside the vehicle wire
clip. (Fig. 2-10)
WIRE SIDE VIEW
(1) Using a side cutter, cut 30 mm of tape
from the 40P connector wire harness to
expose the wires for splicing.
(2) Verify the correct wire and connector
openings are chosen for splicing.
(s) Wrap the V5 harness’ white 40P connector
with one large piece of foam tape. (Fig. 2-12)
(t) Secure the V5 harness’ GREEN/RED and
GRAY/GREEN wires to the vehicle harness
with two medium wire ties. (Fig. 2-12)
Side Cutter
V5 Harness
Medium Wire
Ties (x2)
(u) Secure the V5 harness’ microphone wire to
the vehicle harness with three medium wire
ties. (Fig. 2-13)
40P (White)
Fig. 2-12
Large Foam Tape
Side Cutter
Medium Wire
Ties (x3)
V5 Harness
To Microphone
Fig. 2-13
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 6 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
ECU Mounting Bracket
V5 ECU
3. V5 ECU Preparation and Installation.
(a) Insert the ECU mounting bracket into the
indicated bracket slot on the V5 ECU.
(Fig. 3-1)
(1) Before beginning this section, verify the
protective sheet covering the blower
assembly is still fully in place.
Fig. 3-1
(b) Plug the V5 harness’ white 40P connector
into the V5 ECU. (Fig. 3-2)
10mm Wrench, Needle Nose Pliers
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
Nut
V5 Harness
(c) Install the V5 ECU on the metal substructure
of the reinforcement tube with the nut
supplied in the kit. (Fig. 3-2)
Protective
Sheet
40P (White)
(1) Locate the existing stud bolt on top of the
metal substructure.
V5 ECU
Fig. 3-2
Side Cutter
Vehicle
Harness
V5 Harness
Medium Wire
Tie
(2) Use needle nose pliers to place the nut
over the stud bolt. Start the nut by hand,
and finish tightening with a 10mm
wrench.
(3) Be careful not to drop and lose the nut.
Large Wire Tie
Reinforcement
V5 ECU
Fig. 3-3
(d) Secure the V5 harness to the vehicle harness
with one medium wire tie and secure the V5
harness to the reinforcement tube with one
large wire tie. (Fig. 3-3)
4. GBS ECU Preparation and Installation.
Flat Blade Screwdriver
(a) Turn the adjustment screw on the GBS ECU
to the “9” position. (Fig. 4-1)
GBS ECU
Fig. 4-1
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 7 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
Butyl Tape
(b) Insert the GBS ECU mounting bracket into
the indicated bracket slot on the GBS ECU.
(Fig. 4-2)
(1) Attach the bracket as shown.
GBS ECU
(2) Make sure the bracket is firmly attached
to the ECU.
Mounting
Bracket
Fig. 4-2
(c) Apply the butyl tape to the GBS ECU as
shown. (Fig. 4-2)
(d) Locate and remove the existing bolt from the
connector block in the passenger side cowl
area. (Fig. 4-3)
10mm Socket
(1) Discard the existing bolt.
Existing Bolt
(e) Mount the GBS ECU on the right side of the
connector block with the bolt supplied in the
kit. (Fig. 4-4)
(f) Plug the V5 harness’ white 8P connector into
the GBS ECU. (Fig. 4-4)
Fig. 4-3
10mm Socket
Fig. 4-4
Issue: B
GBS ECU
8P (White)
04/22/05
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
Bolt
Page 8 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
Under-Dash Cover
10mm Socket
5. Microphone Installation.
(a) Using 3MTM Prep Solvent-70, clean the area
indicated on the back side of the under-dash
cover. (Fig. 5-1)
Large Hole
(b) When cleaning with 3MTM Prep Solvent-70:
Microphone
45˚
Insulator
Fig. 5-1
10mm Socket
Small Foam Tape
Microphone
Fig. 5-2
(1) Always use a clean (lint free scratch
resistant) soft cloth (or wipe), and clean a
small area at a time (3x3-ft. max.).
(2) Shake well.
(3) Apply 3MTM Prep Solvent-70 to cloth or
wipe. Do not spray cleaning solution
directly on any vehicle surfaces.
(4) Clean the surface thoroughly and wipe
dry immediately with a new clean cloth.
Do not allow cleaner to air dry.
(c) Remove the backing sheet and secure the
microphone to the back side of the underdash cover. (Fig. 5-1)
(1) Secure the microphone under the
insulator at a 45˚ angle with the back of
the microphone lined up with the front
edge of the large hole as shown.
(Fig. 5-1)
(2) Do not touch the adhesive surface of the
microphone.
(3) Press the microphone to the under-dash
cover firmly.
(d) Secure the microphone with a small strip of
foam tape. (Fig. 5-2)
(1) Do not cover the opening of the
microphone with the foam tape.
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 9 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
(e) Plug the microphone’s 2P connector into the
V5 harness’ 2P connector. (Fig. 5-3)
Small Foam Tape
V5 Harness
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
2P (White)
Microphone
(f) Wrap the 2P connectors with a small strip of
foam tape. (Fig. 5-3)
(g) Reinstall the under-dash cover. (Fig. 5-3)
Fig. 5-3
Under-Dash Cover
6. Warning Label and Key Tag Installation.
(a) Clean the inside surface of the front door’s
windows using 3MTM Prep Solvent-70 and
the method in Step 5(b). (Fig. 6-1)
10mm
Warning Label
(b) Place the warning label on the inside surface of
the front door’s window as shown. (Fig. 6-1)
(1) Use a piece of clear adhesive tape to lift
the labels off the protective backing
sheet.
Fig. 6-1
Remote Control
Key
Ring
Fig. 6-2
Issue: B
(2) Do not touch the adhesive surface of the
warning labels.
(c) Attach the key tag to the remote control
key’s ring. (Fig. 6-2)
Key Tag
04/22/05
Page 10 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Procedure
7. Completing the Installation
Torque Wrench, 10mm Socket
45 deg.
Negative
Battery
Cable
(a) Complete the reassembly of the vehicle.
(1) Reconnect any disconnected connectors.
(2) Verify the panels fit together properly
with no uneven gaps between them.
Battery
(b) Clean up and remove any trash.
(c) Reconnect the vehicle’s negative battery
cable. (Fig. 7-1)
Fig. 7-1
(1) Position the negative terminal at an angle
of 30º to the battery as shown.
(2) Tighten the nut to 4.1 N•m (36 lbf•in).
(3) Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when replacing the cable.
(d) Place the owner’s manual and warranty card,
left in their protective bags, in the glove box.
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 11 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Press and release the remote control’s lock
button to start the system’s arming process.
1. The turn signal lights flash once.
All doors lock.
The Security LED lights up.
Wait 30 seconds.
2.After 30 seconds, the LED starts flashing;
the system is now armed.
Press and release the remote control’s
unlock button to disarm the system.
3. The turn signal lights flash twice.
The driver’s door unlocks.
The LED stops flashing.
Open the driver’s door, insert the key
into the ignition switch and turn it to
“ON.”
Roll down all the windows, remove the
key and exit the vehicle.
Arm and disarm the system with the remote
again, then wait 30 seconds.
4. The doors automatically relock.
The system automatically starts the
arming process.
Press and release the remote control’s
5. Refer to Step 3.
unlock button again to stop the arming
process.
Insert the key into the driver’s door key
cylinder and turn it toward the front of the
6. All doors lock.
The LED lights up.
vehicle to start the arming process.
Wait 30 seconds.
7. After 30 seconds, the LED starts
flashing; the system is now armed.
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 12 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Reach inside and manually unlock the
8. The driver’s door automatically relocks.
driver’s door to trigger an alarm.
The horn sounds repeatedly.
The headlights flash repeatedly.
The turn signal lights flash repeatedly.
The LED lights up.
Manually unlock the driver’s door again
9. The driver’s door lock attempts to lock
and hold it unlocked, open the door, then sit
repeatedly.
in the driver’s seat.
The horn continues to sound repeatedly.
The headlights and turn signal lights
continue flashing.
The LED remains on.
Insert the key into the ignition switch and
turn it to “START’ to stop the alarm.
10. The horn stops sounding.
All the lights stop flashing and/ or turn
off.
The LED turns off.
The starter cranks and the engine starts.
Turn the key back to “LOCK,” remove
it, then exit the vehicle.
With the door open, press the lock switch
on the door to lock the doors, then close the
11. All doors lock.
The LED lights up.
door to start the system’s arming process.
Wait 30 seconds.
12. After 30 seconds, the LED starts
flashing; the system is now armed.
Reach inside and manually unlock the front
passenger’s door to trigger an alarm.
13. The front passenger’s door
automatically relocks.
The horn sounds repeatedly.
The headlights flash repeatedly.
The turn signal lights flash repeatedly.
The LED lights up.
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 13 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Press and release the remote control’s
14. The horn stops sounding.
unlock button to stop the alarm.
All the lights stop flashing.
The LED turns off.
Press and release the remote control’s lock
15. Refer to Steps 1 and 2.
button to start the system’s arming process,
then wait 30 seconds until the system is
armed.
Unlock and open one of the rear passenger
16. Refer to Step 13.
doors to trigger an alarm.
Repeat the above steps with the other rear
17. Refer to Steps 15 and 16.
passenger door and back door (if equipped).
Roll up all windows, remove the key and
exit the vehicle.
Press and release the remote control’s lock
18. Refer to Step 1.
button to start the arming process.
19. After 30 seconds, the LED starts
Wait 30 seconds.
flashing; the system is now armed.
Perform the following check in a
temperature-controlled environment
(50º-90º F)
Pull the striker tool all the way out to tap
20. The horn sounds repeatedly.
the center of the drivers door window to
The headlights flash repeatedly.
trigger an alarm.
The turn signal lights flash repeatedly.
The LED lights up.
NOTE: Adjust as necessary by increasing
the GBS setting to the next level if the
alarm does not trigger during the functional
verifications.
NOTE: If you do not disarm the system,
The alarm will last 20 seconds. It is not
necessary to check the alarm duration.
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 14 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Insert the key into the driver’s door key
21. The horn stops sounding.
cylinder and turn it toward the back of the
All the lights stop flashing and/ or turn
vehicle to stop the alarm.
off.
The Security LED turns off.
Vehicle Function Checks
Head Lights
Functioning Head Lights
High Beams
Functioning High Beams
Turn Signal Lights
Functioning Turn Signal Lights
Tail Lights
Functioning Tail Lights
Stop Lights
Functioning Stop Lights
Backup Lights
Functioning Backup Lights
Hazard Lights
Functioning Hazard Lights
Marker Lights
Functioning Marker Lights
Dome/Courtesy Lights
Functioning Dome/Courtesy Lights
Panel/Switch Illumination
Functioning Switch/Illumination
Accessory Controls/Illumination (if
Functioning Accessory Controls/Illumination
equipped)
Issue: B
Key Sensor Buzzer
Functioning Key Sensor
Fog Lights (if equipped)
Functioning Fog Lights
Daytime Running Lights (if equipped)
Functioning DR Lights
04/22/05
Page 15 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Trunk/Tailgate/Bed Lights (if equipped)
Functioning Lights
Glove Box Light (if equipped)
Functioning Glove Box Light
Cruise Control Light (if equipped)
Functioning Cruise Control Light
Seat Belt Warning Light
Functioning Seat Belt Warning Light. If the
warning light remains on, it may indicate a
system malfunction.
Air Bag Warning Light
Functioning Air Bag Warning Light. If the
warning light remains on, it may indicate a
system malfunction.
ABS Light (if equipped)
Functioning ABS Light. If the warning light
remains on, it may indicate a system
malfunction.
Lamp Failure Sensor (if equipped)
Functioning Lamp Failure Light. If the
warning light remains on, it may indicate a
system malfunction.
Track/Skid Control Light (if equipped)
Functioning Track/VSC Light. If the
warning light remains on, it may indicate a
system malfunction.
Issue: B
HVAC
Functioning HVAC Controls
Power Locks (if equipped)
Functioning Power Locks
Power Windows (if equipped)
Functioning Power Windows
Power Seats (if equipped)
Functioning Power Seats
Power Sunroof (if equipped)
Functioning Sunroof
Horn
Functioning Horn
Gauges
Functioning Gauges
Front Wiper/Washer
Functioning Front Wiper/Washer
04/22/05
Page 16 of 17 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V5 (RS3200PLUS)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Rear Wiper/Washer (if equipped)
Functioning Rear Wiper/Washer
Clock (if equipped)
Functioning Clock
Accessory Power Socket (if equipped)
Functioning Power Socket
Starter
Functioning Starter
Audio/Video (if equipped)
Functioning Audio/Video
Power Sliding Door (if equipped)
Functioning Power Sliding Door
Convenience Memory Settings (if
Functioning Memory Settings
equipped)
Heated Seats (if equipped)
Functioning Heated Seats
Massage Seats (if equipped)
Functioning Massage Seats
Rear Window Defogger (if equipped)
Functioning Rear Window Defogger
Power Side Mirrors (if equipped)
Functioning Power Side Mirrors
Side Mirror Defogger (if equipped)
Functioning Side Mirror Defogger
Front Windshield Defogger (if equipped)
Functioning Front Windshield Defogger
Navigation System (if equipped)
Functioning Navigation System
Power Back Door (if equipped)
Functioning Power Back Door
Remove the appropriate fuse after checks
are completed.
Issue: B
04/22/05
Page 17 of 17 pages
2003-
4RUNNER TVIP V5
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200 PLUS
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
CONNECTOR1
CIRCUIT
MEASUREMENT
1 - Ground
SUB +B Power (Dome)
Always Approx. 12V
2 - Ground
+B Power (Dome)
Always Approx. 12V
3
Trunk Key Input
Continuity when key turned to open
4 - Ground
Key Unlock Warning Input
Continuity when key is in the ignition switch
5
N/C
6 - Ground
7 - Ground
G.B.S. Input
8 - Ground
N/C
9 - Ground
N/C
10
MPX signal
11 Ground
ECU Ground
Continuity
12 - Ground
LED Output
Approx. 1.8V when LED on, 0V when LED off 0V during triggering
13 - Ground
Starter Cut Input
Approx. 12V when ignition switch at ST position, 0V during
triggering
14 Ground
IG Input
15
0V (Pulsed) when window hit
Approx. 12V when ignition switch is in ON position
N/C
16
N/C
17
N/C
18
N/C
19
N/C
20
N/C
21
N/C
22
N/C
23
N/C
24
N/C
25
N/C
26 - Ground
Starter Cut Output
Approx 12V when ignition switch is in ON position
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: Remote Control Inoperative
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Key Unlock wire, weak or dead battery in remote, remote programmed improperly (see KNOWN
ISSUES page), remote not programmed, connectors not plugged in securely.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the panic mode
operation work?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the key unlock warning wire’s splice location (does
not apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Clear the remote control codes from the ECU, then reprogram both (or
all) remotes (they may have accidentally been programmed for second
channel output).
No
control(s) and carefully clean the battery and contacts, then check the
battery for a minimum 2.7V during remote operation. Replace the battery
if necessary.
Clear the remote control codes from the ECU, then reprogram both (or
all) remotes (they may have accidentally been programmed for second
channel output).
Check the automatic door locking/unlocking function.
Open
the
remote
Do the vehicle’s door
Yes
locks work with the door
switches or key?
No
Check and correct the key unlock warning wire’s splice location (does not
apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Confirm the door lock control connectors are plugged in securely. Disconnect the RS3200PLUS harness’ Door Lock Control connectors and reconnect the vehicle’s connectors, then try again, If there is no function, there
is probably a problem with one vehicle’s components.
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: System Inoperative (No Remote Arming/Disarming)
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Key Unlock Warning wire, mis-spliced door courtesy wire, connectors not plugged in securely, Fuse
or shortpin not installed in vehicle, blown fuse in RS3200PLUS harness (does not apply to all vehicles).
What to Ask and Verify
Do the vehicle’s door
Yes
locks work with the door
switches or key?
No
What to Check
Check and correct the key unlock warning wire’s splice location (does not
apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Confirm the door lock control connectors are plugged in securely. Disconnect the RS3200PLUS harness’ Door Lock Control connectors and reconnect the vehicle’s connectors, then try again, If there is no function, there
is probably a problem with one vehicle’s components.
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: No Head Light Function
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Head Lamp wire, connectors not plugged in securely, blown Head Lamp fuse.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the head lamp
switch in the vehicle
work?
Is there continuity
between pin 10 of the
RS3200PLUS harness’
ECU connector?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the head light wire’s splice location (applies to most
vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Check for continuity between the RS3200PLUS ECU connector and the
head lamp circuit connection.
No
Check the vehicle’s head lamp fuse and replace if necessary.
Confirm that the combination switch connector for the head lamp circuit is
plugged in securely.
Yes
Activate the panic mode and check pin 10 for pulsed continuity to ground.
If there is continuity, check fix the wire harness.
Check the RS3200PLUS ECU for signs of liquid damage; it may be necessary to open the ECU case. LIQUID DAMAGE ITEMS ARE NOT COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
No
If no continuity, there is a wire harness problem. Fix as necessary.
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: No Horn Function
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Horn wire, connectors not plugged in securely, blown Horn fuse.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the horn switch in
the vehicle work?
Is there continuity
on pin 10 of the
RS3200PLUS harness’
ECU connector?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the horn wire’s splice location (applies to most
vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Check for continuity between the RS3200PLUS ECU connector and the
horn circuit connection.
No
Check the vehicle’s horn fuse and replace if necessary.
Confirm that the combination switch connector for the horn circuit is
plugged in securely.
Yes
Activate the panic mode and check pin 10 for pulsed continuity to ground.
If there is continuity, check fix the wire harness or check BODY ECU
signal.
Check the RS3200PLUS ECU for signs of liquid damage; it may be necessary to open the ECU case. LIQUID DAMAGE ITEMS ARE NOT
COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
If no continuity, there is a wire harness problem. Fix as necessary.
No
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: No Tail Light Or Marker Light Operation
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced Tail Light wire, connectors not plugged in securely, blown fuse.
What to Ask and Verify
Do the vehicle’s tail
lights work?
Is there continuity
on pin 10 of the
RS3200PLUS harness’
ECU connector?
What to Check
Yes
Check and correct the tail light wire’s splice location (applies to most
vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Verify the RS3200PLUS harness’ tail light circuit connectors are plugged
in securely.
Check for continuity between the RS3200PLUS ECU connector and the
tail light circuit connection.
No
Confirm that the vehicle’s connector for the tail light circuit is plugged
in securely.
Disconnect the RS3200PLUS harness’ tail light circuit connectors and
reconnect the vehicle’s connectors, then check the tail light function
again. If they work, check the RS3200PLUS harness. If not, the problem
is vehicle-related. (applies to some vehicles)
Activate the panic mode and check pin 10 for pulsed continuity to
ground. If there is continuity, check the RS3200PLUS ECU for signs of
liquid damage; it may be necessary to open the ECU case. LIQUID
DAMAGE ITEMS ARE NOT COVERED UNDER WARRANTY.
Yes
No
Check and fix the RS3200PLUS harness.
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: LED Inoperative (No blinking, No turning on)
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-spliced LED wire, mis-spliced door courtesy wire, connectors not plugged in securely.
What to Ask and Verify
Does the LED blink during arming?
Yes
No
What to Check
No problem.
Check trunk key switch was installed properly.
If not correct, LED may not turn on.
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
TROUBLESHOOTING
INFORMATION
RS3200PLUS SECURITY SYSTEM
Complaint: System Inoperative (Duplicate Panic Alarm)
Common causes for this complaint:
Mis-connection of Panic signal wire with terminal, mis-spliced panic signal wire, connector not plugged
in securely.
What to Ask and Verify
What to Check
Does the duplicate panic Yes
mode operation work?
Check the panic signal wire’s splice location.
(Does not apply to all vehicles).
Verify the splice connector was applied properly.
Confirm the panic signal wire with terminal location.
Check door lock control connector is plugged in securely.
No
No Problem
TOYOTA
Section I
4RUNNER
2003 −
CARGO NET
Installation Preparation
Part Number: PT347−89030
Section I Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
1
General Applicability
Description
Spider Floor Net
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Accessory
*Mandatory
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Quantity Reqd.
Legend
Description
STOP
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury
Conflicts
Note:
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
None
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: This calls out the specific
tools and equipment required for this process
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
None
Special Chemicals
None
Rev: A
05/15/02
Page 1 of 2 pages
Supplier Ref #: 5INS023030TA
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
Section II
Installation Procedure
Section II
Installation Procedure
2003 −
CARGO NET
A. Attach Cargo Net
1. Locate anchor points, two D−rings, and four
buttons. (Fig. A−1)
2. Attach the hooks at the top of the net to the D−
rings. (Fig. A−2)
Fig. A−1
3. Attach loops at the bottom of the net to the
four buttons on the underside of the cargo
platform. (Fig A−3)
4. Confirm completed assembly. (Fig. A−4)
Fig. A−2
Fig. A−3
Fig. A−4
TOYOTA
Section III
4RUNNER
2003 −
CARGO NET
Functional Verifications
Section III
Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Confirm that net is attached properly to
Make sure hooks are attached to D−rings
anchor points in the vehicle.
and loops are attached to four buttons on
the underside of the cargo platform.
Rev: A
05/15/02
Page 2 of 2 pages
Supplier Ref #: 5INS023030TA
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section I – Installation Preparation
Part Number: 08380-35802
Section I – Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
General Applicability
Description
Right Side Rail
Left Side Rail
End Cushion (Front RH)
End Cushion (Rear RH)
End Cushion (Front LH)
End Cushion (Rear LH)
Cross Bar
End Support Cover (Front RH)
End Support Cover (Rear RH)
End Support Cover (Front LH)
End Support Cover (Rear LH)
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
*Mandatory
Legend
STOP
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
8
1
Accessory
Description
M8 bolt (corner clamping part)
DIO Installation Manual
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Calls out the specific tools
and equipment recommended for this process.
Additional Items Required for Installation
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Conflicts
Note:
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
Safety glasses
Vehicle protection
Masking tape ( ½" to 1")
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
Socket
Torx socket
Torque wrench
Screwdriver
Cloth
Special Chemicals
Cleaner
Issue: A
09/06/02
12 mm (M8)
TX-25
Thin blade
Lint-free
3MTM Prep Solvent-70
Page 1 of 6 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section II – Installation Procedure
Section II – Installation Procedure
Protective
Tape
Molding Joint Cover
A. Installation Preparations
1. For ease of installation, the temperature of the
work location and the surface of the body
must be at least 60º F (15.5º C).
Protective
Tape
Do NOT remove Middle
Molding Joint Covers
Molding Joint Cover
B. Preparing the Body
1. Clear dust and dirt from the roof of the vehicle
with 3MTM Prep Solvent-70.
i.
TM
When cleaning with 3M Prep
Solvent-70 follow the manufacturer’s
directions. Do not allow cleaner to air
dry.
Fig. C-1
Molding Joint Cover
Clip
Clip
1
3
C. Removal of Molding Joint Cover and Bracket
1. To install the side rails the front and rear
molding joint covers on both sides must be
removed. (Fig. C-1)
STOP
2
Fig. C-2
Interlocking
Back Clip
2. When removing the molding joint covers, to
prevent vehicle body damage, apply protective
tape (masking tape) to both ends of the
grooved moldings and to both sides of the
factory molding joint groove. (Fig. C-1)
3. Remove the molding joint cover by pushing
the molding joint cover in the direction of the
arrow molded into the cover with your finger
Fig. C-2 .
Bracket
Bracket
M8 Bolt
Fig. C-3
4. Disengage the cover from the interlocking
back clip by lightly pulling up (Fig, C-2) ,
push the molding joint cover in the opposite
direction and remove the cover.
Thin Blade Screwdriver
5. Using a 12mm socket, remove and discard the
eight M8 bolts. (Fig. C-3)
6. Remove the bracket. In the event that the
bracket will not come off, use a thin slotted
screwdriver to assist with removal. (Fig. C-4)
Issue: A
09/06/02
Page 2 of 6 pages
Bracket
Fig. C-4
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section II – Installation Procedure
7. Once you have removed the bracket, peel off
the protective tape (masking tape).
After Bracket Removal
Collar
Nut
8. Do not remove the molding. In the event that
it does come off, reattach it in the same
position.
9. Completely remove any dry screw seals, paint
chips, or dirt, to retain the integrity of the seal.
(Fig. C-5)
Clean surface
Fig C-5
D. Checking Cushion Fitting
1. Make sure that the holes of the front end
support of the side rails match the protruding
part of the front end cushion. (Fig. D-1)
Enlarged View of Front End
Cushion Installation
2. Make sure that the holes of the rear end
supports of the side rails match the protruding
part of the rear end cushion. (Fig. D-2)
3. Match the three (3) front end and two (2) rear
end locations of the boss of the cushions to the
holes of the end supports. Install the cushions
as shown in Fig. D-3.
Side Rail
Cushion
Fig D-1
Enlarged View of Rear End
Cushion Installation
Side Rail
Fig D-2
Cushion
Cushion Boss Section
(Before Installation)
(After Installation)
Fig D-3
Issue: A
09/06/02
Page 3 of 6 pages
Push in
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section II – Installation Procedure
E. Assemble the Roof Rack
STOP
1. Carefully place each side rail onto the roof,
ensuring that the support parts at the ends
coincide with the holes in both ends of the
molding. (Fig. E-1)
Side Rails
2. To prevent any damage to the body, have an
assistant help you when placing the side rails.
3. Make sure that the M8 bolt holes of the end
supports match the collar nut position of the
vehicle body. (Fig. E-2)
Fig E-1
Right and Left Side Front
M8 Bolt - Tighten to
275lbf•In (31 N•M) -
i. When aligning the positions, adjust by
lifting up the end supports. Do not slide
the rails for alignment.
NOTE: When adjusting the side rail
positions be careful not to get the cushion
caught in the track.
4. Attach the end supports to the front end using
M8 bolts (each side has four locations).
Right and Left Side Rear
M8 Bolt - Tighten to
275lb•In (31 N•M)
5. Tighten the end support bolts (M8 bolts) to a
torque of 275 lbf•in (31 N•m).
6. Insert the front and rear cross bars from the
rear of the vehicle into the left and right side
rails.
STOP
i. Check the orientation of the cross bar. If
the arrow stamped at the end of the cross
bar is facing the front of the vehicle, the
orientation is correct. (Fig. E-3)
Fig E-2
Rear of RH Side Rail
Knob
Side Rail
Fig E-3
Issue: A
09/06/02
Page 4 of 6 pages
Knob
Cross Bar
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section II – Installation Procedure
7. In the event that the cross bar will not fit,
loosen the bottom left (driver's side) screws
(TX-25) on the crossbar side and adjust to
appropriate width. After it has been adjusted
and tightened to at 22 lbf•in (2.5 N•m ),
reinsert the side rail. (Fig. E-4)
Screw
8. Tighten the knob by hand at any position.
Fig E-4
9. Insert the clip c at the end of the support
cover, into the hole in the side rail, and
leaving the clip inserted, gently push in the
cover d until it is firmly in position.
(Fig. E-5)
Enlarged View of Mounting Part of
End Support Cover (Front)
End Support Cover (Front)
i. Ensure that clip is firmly located into side
rail. Fig E-6.
10. Make sure the entire support cover has been
fastened completely.
Enlarged View of Mounting Part of
End Support Cover (Rear)
End Support Cover (Rear)
Fig E-5
Detail Drawing
Clip
Side Rail
Fig E-6
Issue: A
09/06/02
Page 5 of 6 pages
End Support Cover
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section II – Installation Procedure
STOP
11. Once installation is complete, confirm that
there is no dirt, dry screw seals or paper
washers remaining on the roof. (Fig E-7)
Detail Showing the Roof Rack Completely Installed
Fig E-7
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 -
FIXED ROOF RACK
Section III – Functional Verifications
Section III – Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Support covers
Confirm that all four support covers are
completely fitted into the corner support
parts at the specified positions and are
facing the correct direction.
Issue: A
09/06/02
Page 6 of 6 pages
DIO
TOYOTA
Section I
4RUNNER
2003 −
FRONT END MASK
Installation Preparation
Part Number: PT218−89030
Section I Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
1
Description
Hood Piece
Fender Bumper piece
Installation Instructions
Hardware Bag
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
2
2
Description
Snap/screw
Washer
General Applicability
This Mask can be fitted to all 4Runner models from 2003
onwards.
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
*Mandatory
Additional Items Required For Installation
Quantity Reqd.
(if applicable)
Legend
STOP
Item #
Accessory
Sport Bumper Trim*
Front End Mask
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
Description
Conflicts
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
Note:
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Calls out the specific tools
and equipment recommended for this process.
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
None
For technical assistance regarding this Toyota product,
please call: 1−800−347−1200.
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
Screwdriver
Screwdriver
Scissors
Phillips Head, #2
Flat Head
Engineered by Toyota to meet cooling requirements.
Please follow these installations instructions in the order
they are written. It will make installing your custom
made mask much easier. Your mask was designed to
have a tight fit, and when fully installed it will be snug.
Don t be afraid to tug
Special Chemicals
None
Issue: A
01/03/03
Page 1 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref#
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
Section II
Installation Procedure
Section II
Installation Procedure
2003 −
FRONT END MASK
A. Protect the Vehicle
STOP
1. Customer Care Information:
NOTE: Important, please observe the following
precautions, the manufacturer cannot be
responsible for damage to paint.
i. Area to be covered by mask must be free
of dirt. The mask, especially the flannel
surface, must be clean.
ii. Both car and mask must be completely
dry. If moisture is present under mask,
and is allowed to dry on the vehicle, it
may cause the paint to cloud. If mask gets
wet, remove and allow to dry completely
before reinstalling.
iii. To clean vinyl and flannel backing use a
mild soap and water solution. (Approx.
one tablespoon of soap per half gallon of
water.) Using a cloth or sponge, gently
rub soiled area until clean. Take care to
rinse with clear water when finished.
Repeat if necessary. Hang out to dry, but
not in direct sunlight.
iv. It is recommended that the mask be
removed before washing the vehicle.
v. If mask should flap due to high speed or
wind conditions, stop car and adjust or
remove the mask.
2. Pre−installation Tip:
i. Remove mask from package and
familiarize yourself with its shape in
relation to the contours of the vehicle.
NOTE: Mask will be easier to install if it is warmed
(to room temperature) before installation.
Issue: A
01/03/03
Page 2 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref#
DIO
TOYOTA
Section II
4RUNNER
2003 −
FRONT END MASK
Installation Procedure
B. Hardware Installation
NOTE: Turning the wheels eases the next operation.
Flathead Screwdriver
Phillips Screwdriver
1. Remove the plastic fastener already installed
in vehicle wheel well area with a flathead
screwdriver (Fig. B−1.)
2. Replace with the snap/screw and washer
(Fig. B−2.) Repeat on opposite side of vehicle.
Fig. B−1
Fig. B−2
C. Hood Piece Installation
1. Open hood.
2. Attach five (5) plastic clips to the upper rear
edge of the grill. Place two (2) pockets over
the edge of the hood to the left and right of the
grill (Fig. C−1.)
Fig. C−1
3. Attach two (2) elastics with S hooks to the
holes at the bottom of the hood. Attach two
(2) elastics with S hooks to the holes at the
top of the hood underneath the grill (Fig. C−2.)
IMPORTANT: Pull elastic straps towards you
NEVER away from you.
D. Bumper Piece Installation
NOTES BEFORE INSTALLATION: If your
vehicle is equipped with a Toyota Sport Bumper Trim
accessory, use scissors to cut just the stitching that
attaches the vinyl flaps to the back of the mask and
remove the flaps. (Fig. D−1.)
Fig. C−2
Scissors
1. Place fender pocket of mask over fender point
above headlight (Fig. D−2.) Attach one (1)
plastic clip to edge of the fender flange.
Repeat on other side of the vehicle.
Fig. D−1
Fig. D−2
Issue: A
01/03/03
Page 3 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref#
DIO
TOYOTA
Section II
4RUNNER
2003 −
FRONT END MASK
Installation Procedure
2. Attach snap at top of wheel well to previously
installed hardware (Fig. D−3.) Repeat on other
side of the vehicle.
3. Insert one (1) plastic flap above the bumper
fascia and below the headlight. Repeat on
other side of the vehicle. (Fig. D−4.)
Fig. D−3
4. Attach three (3) plastic clips to the top edge of
the bumper (Fig. D−4.)
NOTE: Fig D−4 shows only the driver s side clip
and the center clip.
Plastic Clip
5. Attach two (2) plastic clips to the side edge of
the fender well, and two (2) plastic clips to the
bottom edge of the fender well. Repeat on
other side of the vehicle (Fig. D−5.)
Plastic Clip
Plastic Flap
Fig. D−4
6. Attach two (2) elastics with S hooks to the
top of the intake opening. (Fig. D−6.)
7. Attach four (4) elastics with S hooks to the
bottom of the intake opening. (Fig. D−6.)
8. Attach three (3) plastic clips to the bottom
edge of the bumper. (Fig. D−6.)
Fig. D−5
9. Hook one (1) elastic with S hook to the
other elastic with S hook underneath the
bumper bracket (Fig. D−7.) Repeat on other
side of vehicle.
Elastics
S−Hooks (x2)
Elastics
S−Hooks (x4)
Vehicle shown with Front Sport
Bumper Trim
Plastic Clips (x3)
Fig. D−6
Vehicle shown with Front Sport
Bumper Trim
Fig. D−7
Issue: A
01/03/03
Page 4 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref#
DIO
TOYOTA
Section II
4RUNNER
2003 −
FRONT END MASK
Installation Procedure
10. Attach the elastics with S hooks to the rear
edge of the bumper guard bracket (Fig. D−8.)
E. Installation Instructions
1. Place installation instructions in glove box for
customer future reference.
Fig. D−8
TOYOTA
Section III
4RUNNER
2003 −
FRONT END MASK
Functional Verifications
Section III
Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Vehicle and mask are free of dirt.
Verify that there are no smudges or dirt
particles.
Verify that any area that may have been wet
Vehicle and mask are dry.
is completely dry.
Verify that headlights, markers, turn signals,
Mask is properly adjusted.
cooling intakes and ducts are unobstructed.
Verify that there is no flapping and the mask
Mask has proper fit.
fits tightly.
Issue: A
01/03/03
Page 5 of 5 pages
Supplier Ref#
DIO
TOYOTA
Section I
4RUNNER
2003 −
HOOD PROTECTOR
Installation Preparation
Part Number: PT427−89030
Section I Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
Quantity Req.
1
1
Description
Hood Protector
Hardware Bag
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
Quantity Req.
6
2
4
2
2
2
6 pieces
9
1
Description
10−24 x 3/8" Screw
Flat Washer
Grill Bracket
End Bracket
Well Nut
6−32 x ½" Screw
Urethane Pad (2 pieces per
strip)
DIO Instruction Sheet
General Applicability
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
*Mandatory
Legend
STOP
Quantity Req.
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Calls out the specific tools
and equipment recommended for this process.
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Accessory
Description
Conflicts
Note: Front End Mask
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
None
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
Screwdriver
Right Angle Screwdriver
Socket
Ratchet Wrench
Cloth
Phillips #2
Phillips #2
10 mm, ¼" Drive
¼" Drive
Lint−free
Special Chemicals
3MTM Prep Solvent−70
Cleaner
Issue: C
11/05/02
Page 1 of 3 pages
Supplier Ref #: I−954
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
Section II
Installation Procedure
Section II
Installation Procedure
2003 −
HOOD PROTECTOR
(Side) Grill Retaining Nuts
A. Pre−Installation Preparation
1. Inspect and verify the kit contents.
(Upper) Grill
Retaining Nuts
2. Open the hood.
Fig. B1
STOP
3. Make sure front edge of hood and grill,
where the deflector is to be installed, is clean
and free from dirt and/or debris. Use 3MTM
Prep Solvent−70 and a clean lint free cloth.
Section A
i. When cleaning with 3MTM Prep
Solvent−70 follow the manufacturer s
directions. Do not allow cleaner to air dry.
Section B
Urethane
Pad
B. Prepare the Deflector for Installation
1. Cover engine bay completely with a
protective blanket to catch any dropped
hardware.
Section A
Section B
Urethane
Pad
Fig. B2
2. Remove the grill from the hood.
i. Using a 10 mm socket, remove eight (8)
nuts holding grill to the hood. (Fig. B1)
ii. Unhook hood latch to separate grill.
Fig. B3
3. Apply the six (6) urethane pads to the hood in
the locations shown. (Fig. B2)
Hood
i. The urethane pads wrap around the front
edge of the hood. (Fig. B2)
Urethane
Pad
4. Place center grill brackets in locations shown.
(Fig. B3)
i. The brackets go between the grill and the
hood and are secured by the grill studs.
(Fig. B4)
Bracket
Grill
Grill Stud
Fig. B4
ii. Re−attach the grill to the hood. Re−install
eight (8) nuts. Re attach hood latch.
5. Install the outer hood brackets in the
locations shown. (Fig. B5)
Issue: C
11/05/02
Fig. B5
Page 2 of 3 pages
Supplier Ref #: I−954
DIO
TOYOTA
Section II
4RUNNER
2003 −
HOOD PROTECTOR
Installation Procedure
i. Insert a well nut into each of the holes.
(Fig. B6)
ii. Attach the bracket to the hood using the
6−32 x ½" screw and washer. The washer
goes between the screw head and bracket.
Fig. B6
C. Install the Shield Assembly to the Vehicle
1. Peel back protective film from shield in
location where screws attach to brackets.
Shield
2. Line up shield with the center grill brackets
making sure the shield is centered.
Bracket
3. Screw shield to grill brackets using four (4)
10−24 x 3/8" screws. Hand start screws.
(Fig. C1)
4. Line up shield with the outer hood brackets
once again making sure the shield is centered.
Phillips
Screwdriver
Urethane
Pad
Screw
Fig. C1
Grill
5. Screw shield to outer brackets using two (2)
10−24 x 3/8" screws. Hand start screws.
(Fig C2)
Phillips
Screwdriver
Shield
6. Make sure the shield is centered and all six
(6) screws are tight.
Urethane
Pad
7. Close the hood.
8. Remove entire protective film from shield and
discard film.
Fig. C2
TOYOTA
Section III
4RUNNER
Screw
2003 −
Bracket
HOOD PROTECTOR
Functional Verifications
Section III
Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Hood closure.
Hood brackets or hardware should not
contact the headlights.
Clearance of hood protector to hood.
The hood protector (shield) or hardware
should not contact the grill.
Issue: C
11/05/02
Page 3 of 3 pages
Supplier Ref #: I−954
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
RUNNING BOARD
Section I − Installation Preparation
Part Number: 08474−35801
Section I Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
2
2
2
1
General Applicability
Description
Left Hand Running Board
Right Hand Running Board
Front Bracket
Middle Bracket
Rear Bracket
Hardware Bag (Bolt Package)
Quantity Reqd.
12
12
1
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
*Mandatory
Description
M6 Bolt
M8 Bolt
DIO Instruction Sheet
STOP
Quantity Reqd.
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Accessory
Legend
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Note: SR5 model only.
Description
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Calls out the specific tools
and equipment recommended for this process.
Conflicts
Note:
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
Safety Glasses
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
Ratchet
Sockets
Extension
Torque Wrench
1/4" or 3/8" drive
10mm, 12mm
6"
1/4" or 3/8" drive (25 lbf−ft)
Special Chemicals
3MTM Prep Solvent−70
Cleaner
Issue: A
08/30/02
Page 1 of 4 pages
DIOSR52003
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
RUNNING BOARD
Section II − Installation Procedure
Section II
Installation Procedure
A. Remove Running Board from Packaging
1. Remove running board assembly from
package, and place on a clean protected
surface.
2. Verify kit contents and inspect the running
board for damage.
B. Running Board Preparation for Installation
(LH Side)
1. Identify Left Hand Side Platform from Right
Hand Side Platform as shown in Fig. B−1.
Fig. B−1
2. Starting with the left−hand side platform,
identify the front and the rear portions of the
board, as shown in Fig. B−1.
3. Install the front bracket (stamped with the
number 1) by inserting the locating tab (front
of bracket) into the slot in the front part of the
running board, and using two (2) M6 bolts to
attach it. Tighten bolts. See Fig. B−2.
Fig. B−2
4. Torque bolts to 70 lbf−in (8 N−m).
5. Install the middle bracket (stamped with the
number 2) by inserting the locating tab (front
of bracket) into the slot in the front part of the
running board, and using two (2) M6 bolts to
attach it. Tighten bolts. See Fig. B−3.
6. Torque bolts to 70 lbf−in (8 N−m).
Fig. B−3
7. Install the rear bracket (stamped with the
number 3) by inserting the locating tab (front
of bracket) into the slot in the front part of the
running board, and using two (2) M6 bolts to
attach it. Tighten bolts. See Fig. B−4.
8. Torque bolts to 70 lbf−in (8 N−m).
Issue: A
08/30/02
Fig. B−4
Page 2 of 4 pages
DIOSR52003
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
RUNNING BOARD
Section II − Installation Procedure
C. Running Board Installation (LH Side)
1. Ensure the area on the vehicle where running
board will be installed is clean before
proceeding. If necessary clean area with
3MTM Prep Solvent−70.
i.
When cleaning with 3MTM Prep
Solvent−70 follow the manufacturer s
directions. Do not allow cleaner to air
dry.
Fig. C−1
2. Raise board up to vehicle rocker panel.
(See Fig. C−1).
3. Attach front bracket onto the rocker panel hole
by using a M8 bolt as shown in Fig. C−2.
Secure bracket by tightening bolt.
4. Attach rear bracket onto the rocker panel hole
by using an M8 bolt as shown in Fig. C−3.
Secure bracket by tightening bolt.
Fig. C−2
5. Install a second M8 bolt in the front bracket as
shown in Fig. C−4. Secure bracket by
tightening bolts.
Fig. C−3
Fig. C−4
Issue: A
08/30/02
Page 3 of 4 pages
DIOSR52003
DIO
TOYOTA
Section II
4RUNNER
2003 −
RUNNING BOARD
Installation Procedure
6. Install two (2) M8 bolts to attach the middle
bracket as shown in Fig. C−5. Secure bracket
by tightening bolts.
7. Install a second M8 bolt in the rear bracket as
shown in Fig. C−6. Secure bracket by
tightening bolts.
8. Torque all M8 bolts to 275 lbf−in (31N−m)
Fig. C−5
D. Running Board Installation (RH Side)
1. Repeat steps B.1. through C.8. for right hand
side.
Fig. C−6
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
RUNNING BOARD
Section III − Functional Verifications
Section III − Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Visual check of Running Board.
Proper fit.
Re−check all bolts for proper torque.
M6 bolts − 70 lbf−in (8 N−m).
M8 bolts − 275 lbf−in (31N−m)
Issue: A
08/30/02
Page 4 of 4 pages
DIOSR52003
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
SPORT BUMPER TRIM
Section I − Installation Preparation
Part Number: PT212−89032
Section I − Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
General Applicability
Description
Sport Bumper Trim
Upper Mounting Bracket (LH)
Upper Mounting Bracket (RH)
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
Quantity Reqd.
4
2
2
2
2
1
Description
M6 Nylon Insert Nut (Nyloc)
M5 Extruded Panel Nut
M5 x 20 mm Hex Head Bolt
Drill Templates
M5 Compression Li miter
DIO Instruction Sheet
Note: All Trim Levels
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
*Mandatory
Legend
STOP
Quantity Reqd.
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Calls out the specific tools
and equipment recommended for this process.
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
Accessory
Description
Conflicts
Note: None
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
Safety Glasses
Special Tools
None
Installation Tools
Variable Speed D rill Motor
Drill Bit
Drill Stop (x2)
Deburring Tool
Socket
Torque Wrench
1/8" & 3/8"
set to 25 mm
10 mm
30 200 lbf−in (~25N−m)
(e.g. Snap−on P/N QJR217C)
Ratchet
Wiping Cloth
Small Hammer
Screwdriver
Extension
Lint−free, non−scratch
Flat Head
3"
Special Chemicals
None
Issue: D
10/14/03
Page 1 of 4 pages
Supplier Ref #: AI0259−000
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
SPORT BUMPER TRIM
Section II − Installation Procedure
Section II − Installation Procedure
A. Preparation.
Up
1. Verify hardware bag content by referring to
the instruction sheet.
2. Four holes are to be drilled in the bumper
fascia. Fig A−1.
Right
Mounting Holes
(to be drilled)
Fig. A−1
Left
3. Set drill stop to 25 mm for each of the two
drill sizes. Fig. A−2.
1
/8", & 3/8"
B. Mounting Hole Drilling.
1. Wear safety glasses before drilling of the
vehicle.
25 mm
2. Remove drill templates from hardware bag
and assemble so the "RH/Pass Side" marking
is in the same quadrant as shown in Fig. B−1.
3. Firmly place the assembled drill templates on
the right bumper fascia as shown in Fig. B−1.
Lightly tap center of the templates with a
small hammer to mark the drill center.
STOP
Fig. A−2
Up
Right
4. Drill 1/8" pilot hole at the markings. Enlarge
pilot holes to 3/8". Do not drill more than 25
mm into the bumper fascia.
RH Fixture
Configuration
5. Disassemble the drill templates.
6. Reassemble the drill templates so the
"LH/Driver Side" marking is in the same
quadrant as shown in Fig. B−2.
8. Drill 1/8" pilot hole at the markings. Enlarge
pilot holes to 3/8". Do not drill more than 25
mm into the bumper fascia.
LH/Pass Side
Up
Left
Bumper Fascia
Fig. B−2
Issue: D
10/14/03
Bumper Fascia
Fig. B−1
7. Firmly place the assembled drill templates on
the left bumper fascia as shown in Fig. B−2.
Lightly tap center of the template with a small
hammer to mark the drill center.
STOP
RH/Pass Side
Page 2 of 4 pages
LH Fixture
Configuration
Supplier Ref #: AI0259−000
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
SPORT BUMPER TRIM
Section II − Installation Procedure
9. Deburr plastic shavings around each hole if
necessary.
STOP
i.
Wipe chips from sport bumper trim
mounting area with a clean, lint free, non−
scratch cloth.
Previously Dri lled
3
/8" Holes
C. Mounting of the Sport Bumper Trim.
1. Remove and save the existing M8 bolt as
shown in Fig. C−1 from both sides of the
vehicle. Bolts will be required in Step C. 3..
2. Install Sport Bumper Trim by carefully
placing the mounting studs (on the Sport
Bumper Trim) through the previously drilled
holes in the bumper fascia. Remove and
discard rubber bolt covers. Fig C−2
3. Position the Sport Bumper Trim and align the
lower mounting bracket holes with holes on
the vehicle and attach loosely using the M8
bolts from Step C. 1..
Socket, 10 mm
Fig. C−1
Right Side Bumper
Fascia
Existing M8 Bolt
M6 Rubber Bolt
Covers
Right
Rear
Fig. C−2
4. Apply pressure on the Sport Bumper Trim
until the seal makes full contact with the
surrounding bumper fascia surfaces as shown
in Fig. C−3.
Seal
Socket, 10 mm
Torque Wrench
5. Tighten the two (2) M8 Bolts to 16 N−m
(144 lbf−in.) on both sides of the vehicle.
D. Installation of (RH) Upper Mounting Bracket.
1. Open hood and locate right air dam between
radiator support bracket and top of bumper
fascia as shown in Fig. D−1.
STOP
Seal
Fig. C−3
Radiator Support
Bracket
2. Protect bumper fascia with blanket.
3. Remove and discard front pushpin on the side
of the rubber air dam as shown in Fig. D−1.
Pushpin
Air
Dam
Fig. D−1
Issue: D
10/14/03
Page 3 of 4 pages
Supplier Ref #: AI0259−000
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
SPORT BUMPER TRIM
Section II − Installation Procedure
4. Peel back rubber air dam to expose mounting
hole. Install M5 extruded panel nut over the
mounting hole in the radiator support bracket
exposed after removal of pushpin.. Fig. D−2.
5. Place right hand upper mounting bracket over
the two (2) M6 studs as shown in Fig. D−3.
Radiator Support
Bracket
M5 Extruded Panel
Nut
ÂÂÂÂ
ÂÂÂÂ
Fig. D−2
6. Hand tighten two (2) M6 nylon insert nuts
provided onto the Sport Bumper Trim studs.
7. Align top hole in upper mounting bracket to
the hole in radiator support bracket as shown
with M5 extruded panel nut. (Fig. D−4)
Bumper
Fascia
Upper Mounting
Bracket
M6 Nylon
Insert Nut x2
M6 Stud x2
Sport
Bumper
Trim
8. Place M5 compression limiter in rubber air
dam as shown in Fig. D−4.
9. Hand tighten M5 x 20 bolt into M5 extruded
panel nut.
Fig. D−3
Compression
Limite r
M5 Bolt
E. Installation of (LH) Upper Mounting Bracket.
1. Repeat Steps D. 1. to D. 9. for left hand upper
mounting bracket.
Radiator
Support
Bracket
Rubber Air
Dam
Upper Mounting
Bracket
Panel
Nut
F. Final Assembly.
1. Tighten all M6 nuts to 3.4 N−m (30 lbf−in.).
2. Tighten both M5 bolts to 6.8 N−m (60 lbf−in.).
Fig. D−4
Front (Right Hand Side)
3. Remove blanket from bumper fascia.
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2003 −
SPORT BUMPER TRIM
Section III − Functional Verifications
Section III − Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Visual check of Sport Bumper Trim.
Visually centered left to right.
Top edge stanchion visually taller to the
top edge of bumper fascia.
Verify Sport Bumper Trim is fully seated
No visible gap − seal and bumper fascia.
and seal is properly seated.
Seal is evenly pressed against fascia.
Issue: D
10/14/03
Page 4 of 4 pages
Supplier Ref #: AI0259−000
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section I − Installation Preparation
Part Number: PT900− 8903D03 (NSR)
(Charcoal/Stone)
PT900− 8903D16 (NSR) (Taupe)
PT900− 8903S03 (SR)
(Charcoal/Stone)
PT900− 8903S16 (SR) (Taupe)
Section I − Installation Preparation
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
3
4
5
6A
6B
7
8
1
1
1
1
1
2
9
1
10
11
1
1
Description
DVD Player
Flat Panel Display (with screw
caps)
Main Harness
FM Modulator
Trim Ring
FPD Bracket (NSR only)
FPD Bracket (SR only)
DVD Bracket
Wireless Headphones (with
batteries, owner’s manual and
headphone sticker)
Remote Control with (1)
CR2025 battery
Owner’s Manual
Console Warning Label
Quantity Reqd.
4
2
2
4
1
1
2
2
2
6
20
2
Note:
Vehicle with Rear Seat Audio (RSA)
CD Changer (P9)
Recommended Tools
Safety Tools
Safety Goggles
Vehicle Protection
Blankets, Clean Cloths,
Seat Covers, Part Boxes
Special Tools
Templates & Fixtures
In DIO Install Kit
Installation Tools
Drive Ratchet
Screw Gun
Socket
Torque Wrenches (2)
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
3
/8"
8 mm, 10 mm, 14 mm
0−50 lbf−in, 0−50 lbf−ft
e.g. Panel Pry Tool #1
Toyota SST # 00002−06001−01
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3A
3B
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Conflicts
Description
Screw, M5 x 12
Rivnut (M5 thread) (NSR only)
Screw, M5 x 10 (NSR only)
Screw, M6 x 10 (SR only)
Braided Sleeving (SR only)
Spacer, Foam
U−Clip, #8
Screw, Long Self Tapping, #8
Screw, 6−32 x 5/8"
Wire Tie (Large) , 17.5"
Wire Tie (Small), 8"
Foam Pad Sheet, (6 pads per
sheet)
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1A
Quantity Reqd.
1
Description
DIO Install Kit (NSR only)
1B
1
DIO Install Kit (SR only)
Screwdriver Bit
Screwdriver
Shop Vacuum
Rivet Nut Tool
Utility Knife
Side Cutters
Marker Pen
Drill Motor
Drill Bits
Phillips, #2
Phillips # 2, Stubby
Pneumatic, 5 mm Mandrel
Letter "N" (7.7 mm),
Number "32" (2.95 mm)
Drill Stops
Hole Cutter
Saber Saw & Blade
Deburring Tool
Headphones (PT900−00030)
Headphones
DVD Disc
Remote Control
Electrical Tape
1 1/8 "
Blade for cutting plastic
Wireless (for Test)
Wired (for Test)
(for Test)
(for Test)
P/N PT900−89030
P/N PT900−8903S
2A
1
2B
1
W/H Adapter, Premium JBL
Audio, P/N PT900−00038
W/H Adapter, Standard Audio,
P/N PT900−00036
Issue: B
10/08/03
Special Chemicals
Cleaner
3MTM Prep Solvent−70
General Applicability
Note:− All MY2004 4 Runner WITHOUT Rear Seat Audio
(RSA).
Page 1 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section I − Installation Preparation
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
Accessory
DVD VES
EC Mirror
TVIP
*Mandatory
Legend
STOP
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CRITICAL PROCESS: Proceed with caution to ensure
a quality installation.
GENERAL PROCESS: This highlights specific
processes to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Calls out the specific tools
and equipment recommended for this process.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 2 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
Section II − Installation Procedure
NOTES:
STOP
Removed Parts:−
Place all removed parts on a protected surface.
STOP
Connectors:−
When disconnecting connectors, do not pull on
the wires; pull on the connectors.
STOP
Wire Ties:−
When using wire ties to secure harness, clip the
wire ties after securing them.
A. Vehicle Preparation and Protection.
1. Set the emergency brake, and unlock all
vehicle doors.
STOP
10 mm Socket
2. Open the hood and apply protective covers to
the fender/grill area by the battery.
3. Remove the negative battery cable.
(Fig. A−1)
i. Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when removing cable.
Fig. A−1
4. Wait a minimum of 90 seconds after the
vehicle battery is disconnected before
beginning Step B. (for Air Bag safety).
STOP
5. Cover the front and middle seats and the
interior of vehicle using seat covers and
blankets.
B. Headliner Preparation.
Claws (x4)
1. Remove the center dome light assembly.
(Fig. B−1)
i. Remove the lens cover.
ii. Remove and retain the factory bulb.
iii. Disengage the four (4) claws.
iv. Disconnect the center dome light wiring
harness 3−pin connector.
Fig. B−1
Flat Blade Screwdriver
Panel Removal Tool
v. Discard center dome light assembly.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 3 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
NOTE: Eye protection must be worn during the
drilling/cutting process.
Dome Light Opening
Cutting Template (1)
FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT SUNROOF (NSR)
ONLY. (Steps B. 2. through B. 17.)
Roof Bow
2. Attach headliner cutting template (1) to the
factory dome light opening. (Fig. B−2)
Template Locator Tab
i. Cut headliner material away.
Template Hook
ii. Position the template hook securely in the
dome light opening on the forward side
(driver) side of the roof bow.
Fig. B−2
Template
Captive
Screw
iii. Position the template locator tab on the
rear side of the roof bow.
Dashed Lines
Headliner
Slots
iv. Use a screw gun (with Philips #2 bit) to
secure the template to the roof bow by
tightening the (1) # 8, 1 1/4" captive
screw in the template.
3. Mark the dashed lines in the template onto
the headliner using a marker pen. (Fig. B−3)
STOP
Front of Vehicle
Phillips Screwdriver #2,
Screw Gun,
Marker Pen
Fig. B−3
NOTE: Use caution to ensure damage does not
occur to the dome light wiring harness. Hold the
knife perpendicular to the headliner surface. Do
not cut on an angle.
Cutting Template (1)
4. Carefully cut the headliner along the slots in
the template. (Fig. B−4)
STOP
i. Do not cut the dome light wiring harness.
Utility Knife
Fig. B−4
5. Use a screw gun (with Philips #2 bit) to
remove the template.
6. Finish cutting the headliner by cutting along
the marked dashed lines. (Fig. B−5)
STOP
Dome Light
Cutout
Cut Dashed Lines
i. Do not cut the dome light wiring harness.
Fig. B−5
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 4 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
7. Attach the headliner cutting template (2) to
the factory dome light opening. (Fig. B−6)
Dome Light Opening
Cutting Template (2)
Roof Bow
i. Position the template hook securely in the
dome light opening on the forward side
(driver) side of the roof bow.
ii. Position the template locator tab on the
rear side of the roof bow.
iii Use a screw gun (with Philips #2 bit) to
secure the template to the roof bow by
tightening the (1) # 8, 1 1/4" captive
screw in the template.
Template Locator Tab
Template Hook
Template
Fig. B−6
Dashed Lines
#32 Drill Hole
N Drill Bushing
#32 Drill Hole
8. Mark the dashed lines in the template onto
the headliner using a marker pen.. (Fig. B−7)
9. Carefully cut the headliner along the slots in
the template. (Fig. B−7)
STOP
Front of Vehicle
Captive
Screw
Headliner
Slots
N Drill Bushing
Phillips Screwdriver #2,
Screw Gun, Marker Pen,
Deburring Tool
Fig. B−7
i. Do not cut the dome light wiring harness.
10. Set the drill stops on both letter "N" and #32
drill bits to 27 mm. (Fig. B−8)
11. Drill two (2) "N" sized holes using the two
(2) drill bushings (located on the template) as
guides. (Fig. B−7)
27 mm
Drill Stop
2.95 & 7.7 mm Drill Bits,
Drill Gun, Drill Stop
Fig. B−8
Cut Dashed Lines
i. Deburr holes.
Utility Knife
12. Drill two (2) #32 sized holes into the
headliner in the locations indicated on the
template. (Fig. B−7)
STOP
13. Vacuum all debris from floor and seats.
Fig. B−9
14. Use a screw gun (with Philips #2 bit) to
remove the template.
15. Finish cutting the headliner by cutting along
the dashed lines. (Fig. B−9)
16. Install two (2) M5 threaded rivnuts in the
holes drilled in the roof bow. (Fig. B−10)
M5 Rivnuts (x2)
Rivet Nut Gun
Fig. B−10
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 5 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
17. Install the two (2) mounting U−clips.
Position the clips over previously drilled
(#32) holes. (Fig. B−11)
FOR VEHICLES WITH SUNROOF (SR)
ONLY. (Steps B. 18. through B. 28.)
U−Clips
STOP
NOTE: Make sure that the Sunroof and
Sunshade are closed fully. (Forward position)
STOP
NOTE: Use caution to ensure damage does not
occur to the dome light wiring harness. Drop
rear edge of sunroof open and position dome
light harness away from cutting template. Hold
the knife perpendicular to the headliner surface.
Do not cut on an angle.
Fig. B−11
Dome Light
Harness
Slots (x5)
18. Attach the sunroof headliner cutting template
to the factory dome light opening.
i. Cut headliner material to allow template
plus access to roof bow holes.
Rear Edge
ii Position the template locator pins on the
roof bow.
iii Secure the template to the roof bow by
tightening the (1) # 8, 1 1/4" captive
screw in the template.
Fig. B−12
Marker Pen
Utility Knife
19. Use a screw gun (with Philips #2 bit) to
tighten the template screw.
SR Cutting Template Slots (x5)
20. Mark the dashed lines in the template using a
marker pen. (Fig. B−12)
21. Carefully cut the headliner along the slots in
the template. (Fig. B−13)
Fig. B−13
22. Set the drill stop on the #32 drill bit to
27 mm (Fig. B−14)
27 mm
Drill Stop
2.95 mm Drill Bit,
Drill Gun, Drill Stop
Fig. B−14
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 6 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
23. Drill two (2) #32 holes into the headliner in
the locations indicated on the template.
24. Remove the template by loosening the one
(1) captive screw on the template.
U− clips
25. Once the template is removed, cut the
remaining portion of the headliner between
the five (5) slots. (Fig. B−13)
26. Finish cutting the headliner across the dashed
lines. (Fig. B−13)
27. Install two (2) U−clips. (Fig. B−15)
STOP
28. Protect the vehicle center dome light wiring
harness with the braided sleeving (provided
in kit)
i
Compress the braided sleeving so that the
3−pin connector and center dome light
wiring harness can pass through it.
ii
Decompress the protective wiring
harness webbing to expand to its full
length.
iii Tape the protective wiring harness
webbing to the center dome light wiring
harness just below the 3−pin connector
with electrical tape.
Fig. B−15
Clips (x4)
Hood and Fuel
Door Release
Levers
Bolts (x2)
Fig. C−1
8 mm Socket,
Panel Removal Tool
C. Remove Lower Instrument Panel Finish Plate.
1. Remove the instrument panel and finish
panel lower subassembly. (Fig. C−1)
i. Remove and retain the six (6) bolts.
ii. Pull the radio receiver and integration
control panel forward.
iii. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
iv. Disconnect the hood and fuel door release
levers.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 7 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
v. Remove finish panel lower subassembly
and temporarily store in the clear plastic
wire harness bag for protection.
D. Remove Shift Cover, Side Covers and Coin
Box.
1. Cover the shift knob with a protective cloth.
Panel Removal
Tool
2. Remove the shift cover in order from (1) to
(6) using panel removal tool. (Fig. D−1)
3. Use panel removal tool to disengage clips
under left (L) and right (R) side covers.
4. Unplug connectors and remove covers and
coin box.
Fig. D−1
E. Remove Console Cover and Console Box.
1. Remove the console cover. (Fig. E−1)
i. Disengage the console cover clips in
order from (1) to (6) using panel removal
tool.
2. Remove the console box (Fig. E−l) from the
vehicle.
i. Remove the six (6) bolts on console box
with 10 mm socket.
Panel Removal Tool,
10 mm Socket
Fig. E−1
ii. Disconnect the two electrical connectors
from the console box.
F. Remove the Center Console Rear Cover.
1. Use panel removal tool to disengage six (6)
clips on rear cover as shown in the
(Fig. F−1)
Fig. F−1
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 8 of 25 pages
Panel Removal
Tool
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
G. Remove Air Conditioner Cluster, Center
Cluster and Audio.
1. Remove the air conditioner cluster (unit).
i. Cover the face of the air conditioner
cluster assembly with a protective blanket
during the removal procedure.
STOP
ii. Remove the screw on air conditioner
cluster with Phillips screwdriver.
(Fig. G−1)
iii. Remove plug from cluster.
STOP
iv. When removed, wrap the air conditioner
cluster assembly in a protective blanket
and store outside the vehicle.
Phillips Screwdriver,
10 mm Socket,
Panel Removal Tool
2. Remove the center cluster.
Fig. G−1
i. Remove the three (3) bolts on center
cluster with 10 mm socket. (Fig. G−1)
ii. Remove the center cluster in order from
(1) to (6) using panel removal tool.
(Fig. G−1)
iii. Disconnect the two (2) electrical
connectors from center cluster.
(Fig. G−1)
3. Remove the radio.
i. Remove two (2) bolts on radio with 10
mm socket. (Fig. G−1)
ii. Disconnect the connectors from rear of
radio. (Fig. G−1)
H. Glove Compartment Removal.
1. Release glove compartment stoppers, by
pressing inwards on side panels of glove
compartment. (Fig. H−l)
2. Disconnect damper from glove box
opening, leave connected to glove box
assembly.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Phillips #2
Stubby
Screwdriver,
Fig. H−1
Page 9 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
3. Remove four (4) screws and remove the I/P
finish panel #2. (Fig. H−2)
Air Bag Connector
4. Remove the hook on glove compartment.
STOP
STOP
i
Unclip the air bag connector from the
storage box. (Fig. H−2)
NOTE: DO NOT DISCONNECT THE AIR
BAG ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS.
I. Vehicle Disassembly − Headliner Components.
STOP
Phillips #2 Stubby
Screwdriver,
Screws (x 4)
Fig. H−2
1. Remove the roof console box assembly.
(Fig.s I−1. & I−2)
i. Use the panel removal tool to pry the two
(2) retainer clips free. (Fig. I−1)
ii. Verify the clips are not damaged.
Claws (x 3)
iii. Lower the overhead console assembly.
iv. Disconnect the electrical connector.
(Fig. I−2)
Clips (x 2)
Panel Removal Tool
Fig. I−1
2. Remove the LH and RH visor assembly.
(Fig. I−3)
i. Remove the two (2) screws from the
Visor assembly.
Connector
ii. Remove the two (2) screws from the visor
subassembly.
iii. Remove the screw and the visor holder.
3. Remove the upper portion of the front door
opening trim weather strips.
Panel Removal Tool
Fig. I−2
Visor Holder
Phillips Screwdriver
4. Remove the upper portion of the rear door
opening trim weather strips.
Screws (x 4)
Fig. I−3
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 10 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
5. Loosen the top of the B−pillar lower
garnishes by disengaging the eight (8)
claws and two (2) clips. (Fig. I−4)
6. Protect the lower garnish panels with
blanket.
7. Remove the B−pillar upper garnishes.
(Fig. I−5)
Fig. I−4
Panel Removal Tool
i. Remove two (2) bolts.
ii. Disengage six (6) claws and clip.
iii. Slide the center pillar garnishes down
over the seat belt.
CAUTION
DO NOT
REMOVE
CLIP!
8. Remove the LH and RH A−pillar garnish.
(Fig. I−6)
i. Remove the two (2) grab handle plugs.
ii. Remove the two (2) grab handle bolts.
iii. Disengage the two (2) claws and clip.
Bolt (x 2)
Fig. I−5
9. Remove the LH and RH front, center and
rear (if applicable) grab handles. (Fig. I−7)
10 mm Socket
Panel Removal Tool
Clip
i. Remove the two (2) grab handle plugs.
ii. Remove the two (2) screws and grab
handles.
Bolt (x2)
iii. Remove coat hanger hook if applicable.
Claw
10 mm Socket
Panel Removal Tool
Fig. I−6
10 mm Socket
Panel Removal Tool
Screw (x 2)
Fig. I−7
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 11 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
FOR VEHICLES WITH SUNROOF (SR)
ONLY. (Steps I. 10. through I. 16.)
10. Carefully open the C−pillar upper bolt cover
to expose the 10 mm hex head bolt.
(Fig. I−8)
STOP
11. Loosen the upper portion of the LH and RH
rear inner roof side garnish panels, by
disengaging the upper four (4) clips. If clips
are damaged, replace with TOYOTA P/N
90467−12086 during reassembly. (Fig. I−9)
i. Avoid losing clips into body panel.
STOP
Fig. I−8
ii. Remove the tonneau cover (if applicable).
iii. Remove the two (2) bolts.
Clip (xClips
9) (x 4)
12. For vehicles with SR and third row seats,
remove upper seat anchor at passenger side
and driver side "D" pillar.
i. Remove passenger side and driver side
grab handles.
Bolt (x 2)
CAUTION
DO NOT
REMOVE
CLIPS!
13. Remove the upper portion of the backdoor
weather strip.
10 mm Socket,
Panel Removal Tool
Fig. I−9
14. Remove the LH and RH coat hooks by
removing the screw.
Panel Removal Tool
15. Lower the headliner assembly. (Fig. I−9)
Pushpins
i. Remove the four (4) pushpins and
domelight assembly.
ii. Detach the headliner from the VelcroTM
retainers.
STOP
STOP
iii. Place clean cloths between headliner and
the LH and RH rear inner roof side
garnish panels. Headliner must not rest
directly on the panels.
Dome Light
Assembly
Fig. I−10
iv. Avoid creasing headliner by putting too
much pressure on it.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 12 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
16. Lower the headliner so that it rests on the
headrest(s).
J. Center Console Assembly Preparation.
Center Console Box
Bottom
1. Place console box onto drilling fixture.
(Fig. J−1)
Heater Duct
i. Use care to avoid damaging the console.
ii. Ensure drilling fixture is secured to
workbench.
2. Remove the heater duct assembly.
i
Remove the two (2) screws securing the
heater duct with Phillips screwdriver.
(Fig. J−2)
Drilling Fixture
(Secured to
Workbench)
Center Console Holding
Fixture
Fig. J−1
Phillips Screwdriver
Center Console
Holding Fixture
3. Place center console drilling template on
bottom of the center console and use guide
pins of the storage box bottom to position the
template in the correct location. (Fig J−3)
4. Drill six (6) holes using #32 drill (for pilot
hole) and then 11/8" hole cutter. (Fig. J−3).
Fig. J−2
5. Remove the center console drilling template.
Drill Six (6) 11/8" Holes
Center Console
Drilling Template
Fig. J−3
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 13 of 25 pages
Drill Gun, # 32 Drill, 11/8" Hole Cutter
Center Console Drilling Template
Center Console Holding Fixture
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
6. Use saber saw to cut material out between the
four (4) holes (Fig. J−4).
7. Remove all plastic shavings from console
after drilling and cutting is complete.
8. Reinstall the heater duct.
i. Reinstall heater duct using the two (2)
screws securing the heater duct with
Phillips screwdriver. (Fig. J−5)
9. Remove console box from holding fixture.
Remove the Material between the Four (4)
Drilled Holes to Make One (1) Large Hole.
Saber Saw, Center
Console Holding Fixture
Fig. J−4
K. Install Video Display Unit Mounting Bracket.
FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT SUNROOF (SR)
ONLY. (Steps K. 1. through K. 3.)
1. Using 3MTM Prep Solvent−70 clean the
surface of the front roof bow.
i. When cleaning with 3MTM Prep
Solvent−70 follow the manufacturer s
directions. Do not allow cleaner to air
dry.
Fig. J−5
2. Install the NSR mounting bracket. (Fig. K−1)
Phillips Screwdriver
Rivnut (x 2)
3. Peel the paper backing from the adhesive
strip.
i. Install the bracket and secure with the
two (2) M5 screws.
ii. Tighten screws to bracket to 4 N−m
(35 lbf−in)
Adhesive
Tape
Fig. K−1
NSR Mounting Bracket
Phillips Screwdriver
iii. Press the adhesive strip against the roof
bow.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 14 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
FOR VEHICLES WITH SUNROOF ONLY
(Step K. 4..)
4. Install the four (4) M6 mounting screws to
the cross vehicle mounting bracket
i
SR Mounting Bracket MUST be installed with the Direction
Arrow Facing Toward the Front of the Vehicle.
Install the SR mounting bracket to the
roof bow. (Fig. K−2 & K−3).
ii. Tighten screws to bracket to 4 N−m
(35 lbf−in).
Fig. K−2
NOTE: The SR mounting bracket MUST be
installed with direction arrow facing toward the
front of vehicle.
Front of Vehicle
10 mm Socket
Torque Wrench
L. Route the Main Wiring Harness.
STOP
NOTE: It is important to first set the length
before anchoring the wiring harness. All excess
should be positioned behind the radio and
secured with foam tape & wire ties.
STOP
NOTE: Do not allow the flat wire wiring
harness to twist during installation. A twist in
the wiring harness can cause a bulge in the
headliner.
Fig. K−3
1. Route the main wiring harness to headliner.
i. Start routing of main wire wiring harness
10−pin connector from the center IP
opening area.
ii. Route the DVD main wiring harness end
(with the three (3) connectors) along the
RH side of the gear selector assembly and
through the round cutout in the rear
center console bracket. (Fig. L−1)
Existing Weldnut
SR Mounting Bracket
M6 Screws (x 4)
Wire Ties (x 4)
Service Loop
18" Length
Fig. L−1
Red Tape
Foam Tape
(x 3)
iii. Align the red tape on the wiring harness
with the bracket opening and secure using
three (3) foam tapes and four (4) wire ties
in the locations indicated. (Fig. L−1)
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 15 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
iv. Route the long portion of the main wiring
harness (with the single 14−pin connector)
through the glove box opening along the
IP reinforcement bar and up the A−pillar.
(Fig.s L−2. & L−3)
v. Route harness forward of IP
reinforcement bar to allow harness to be
routed up A−pillar. Loosely secure with
four (4) wire ties.
vi. Use the three (3) existing vehicle plastic
harness brackets to secure the DVD main
wiring harness along the A−pillar.
(Fig. L−3)
FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT SUNROOF
ONLY. (Step L. 2.)
Wire Ties (x 4)
Side Cutter
Fig. L−2
Plastic Harness
Brackets
DVD Main
Wiring Harness
2. Route the main wiring harness from the A−
pillar across the headliner near the
windshield to the center of the headliner and
back to the hole cut in the headliner.
STOP
I/P Reinforcement Bar
Fig. L−3
i. Ensure that the wiring harness is routed
under the padding in headliner to prevent
rattles.
Foam Tape
Red Tape to
Opening in
Headliner
ii. Align the red tape on the wiring harness
with RH corner of the headliner opening
(Fig. L−4)
iii. Secure the wiring harness to the headliner
using foam tape.
Padding
Fig. L−4
(1) Use care when applying the foam tape
to prevent creasing the headliner.
STOP
FOR VEHICLES WITH SUNROOF ONLY.
(Step L. 3.)
3. Position and secure the main wiring harness
above the headliner.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 16 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
i. Pull the wiring harness over the sunroof
frame brackets to the roof bow where the
FPD bracket was installed.
ii. Route the wiring harness along the center
of the roof bow (inside of the channel)
and position the red tape on the wiring
harness so it aligns with the passenger
side of the FPD bracket (Fig. L−5)
Foam Tape (x3)
Foam Block
Main Harness
iii. Secure wiring harness to bracket with two
(2) small wire ties. (Fig. L−6)
iv. Secure wiring harness to brackets with
two (2) small wire ties. (Fig. L−7)
v. Secure the wiring harness using foam
tape at three (3) locations indicated.
(Fig. L−5)
vi. Install the 7" foam block by pressing the
adhesive side of the foam block down on
the forward edge of the sunroof bow.
(Fig. L−5)
(1) Make sure that the foam block is
positioned in the center of the roof
bow and in the channel.
Fig. L−5
Red Tape Aligned to Passenger
Side Hole in Headliner
Side Cutter
Fig. L−6
Side Cutter
4. If any excess, gather and secure the excess
wire wiring harness slack in the radio
opening (Fig. L−8)
Fig. L−7
Wire Ties (x 2)
Wire Ties (x 2)
Main Harness
Main Harness
Wire Tie
Side Cutter
Fig. L−8
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 17 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
5. Secure the wiring harness in the glove box
using four (4) large wire ties in the areas
indicated. (Fig. L−9)
Main Harness
I/P Reinforcement Bar
M. Install the Modulator Assembly.
1. If the vehicle is not equipped with diversity
antennas, loop the modulator small antenna
connector back into the modulator.
(Fig. M−1)
Wire Ties (x 4)
Side Cutter
Fig. L−9
2. Connect the DVD main wiring harness
10−pin connector to the modulator assembly.
(Fig. M−2)
Modulator
3. Position the modulator assembly below the
radio opening on top of the main IP wiring
harness.
4. Secure the modulator to the main IP wiring
harness with two (2) large wire ties. One
wire around middle of modulator and one
wire tie on driver side tab of modulator.
(Fig. M−2)
Vehicle
Antenna(s)
Fig. M−1
Modulator
Side Cutter
5. Bundle excess and secure the DVD main
harness to the vehicle harness with one (1)
wire tie as indicated. (Fig. M−2)
Large Wire
Ties (x 2)
DVD Main Harness
Wire Tie
Fig. M−2
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 18 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
N. Connect the Wiring Harnesses in the Radio
Opening.
1. Connect the T−wiring harness 3−pin
connector to the DVD main wiring harness
3−pin connector. (Fig. N−1)
2. Connect the radio T−wiring harness male
connector to the vehicle radio wiring harness
female connector. (Fig. N−1)
3. Position the fuses in the glove box opening.
(Fig. N−2)
DVD Main
Harness 3−pin
Connector
Tee Harness Female
Connector
Vehicle Radio
Harness
Tee Harness 3−pin Connector
Fig. N−1
Wire Ties (x 3)
i. Ensure fuse location does not interfere
with opening and closing of the glove
box.
Side Cutter
ii. Secure wire harness with three (3) wire
ties.
4. Connect the modulator antenna wires to the
radio.
Fuses
Main Harness
Fig. N−2
5. Connect the radio T−wiring harness female
connector to the radio and reinstall the radio
A/C cluster and panels.
O. Install the DVD Player into the Console Box.
1. Reinstall the center console box, and route
the DVD main wiring harness through the cut
hole in the bottom of center console box.
(Fig. O−1)
Fig. O−1
2. Install the main center console bolt inside the
console box on the driver’s side. (Fig. O−2)
3. Install the DVD player mounting bracket into
the factory holes in the center console box
using the remaining factory bolts. (Fig. O−2)
DVD Player Mounting Bracket
8 mm Socket
Factory Bolts
i. Be careful not to scratch the interior of
the center console box when installing the
DVD player mounting bracket.
Fig. O−2
Issue: B
10/08/03
Main Harness
Page 19 of 25 pages
NOTE: Install Main Center
Console Bolt First.
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
ii. If the vehicle is equipped with an AC
inverter, the bracket will need to be
rotated around the AC power outlet
4. Connect the three (3) DVD main wiring
harness electrical connectors to the DVD
player. (Fig. O−3)
5. Install the DVD player into the center
console box using the two (2) DVD player
mounting screws. (Fig. O−4)
STOP
Fig. O−3
i. Use caution when installing the screws in
so that the main wiring harness is not
trapped between the DVD player and the
bottom of the center console box.
ii. Use the storage box opening at the back
of the center console box to remove slack
in the DVD main wiring harness when
installing the DVD player.
Screws (x 2)
Phillips Screwdriver
Fig. O−4
P. Install DVD Video Display Unit.
Pushpins
FOR VEHICLES WITH SUNROOF ONLY.
(Step P. 1.)
1. Install the roof headliner with the four (4)
pushpins. (Fig. P−1)
2. Connect the DVD video display unit.
(Fig. P−2)
Fig. P−1
i. Connect the factory dome light wiring
harness connector to the DVD video
display unit.
ii. Connect the DVD main wiring harness
connector to the DVD video display unit.
DVD Main Harness
Dome Light
Harness
3. Mount the DVD video display unit.
i. Place the DVD main harness and dome
light harness in channel of roof bow,
above mounting bracket.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Fig. P−2
Page 20 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
ii. Make sure wire harnesses do not interfere
with sunshade movement. (Fig. P−3)
iii. Secure with foam tape.
iv. Remove the dome light lens cover.
(Fig. P−4)
v. Lower the video screen to access the
mounting holes.
Fig. P−3
vi. Mount the DVD video display unit to the
bracket with four (4) M5 screws.
(Fig. P−4)
Phillips Screwdriver,
Torque Wrench
(1) Tighten screws to bracket to 1.2 N−m
(10 lbf−in).
Factory Bulb
Dome Light
Lens Cover
vii. Install the previously removed factory
dome light bulb. (Fig. P−4)
viii. Install two (2) #8 screws into the U−clips
and tighten.
M5 Screws (x4)
Screw Caps (x4)
Fig. P−4
ix. Install the dome light lens cover.
x. Install the four (4) screw cap covers
under the video screen. (Fig. P−4)
Place CAUTION Label
Here
Center Console
Lid
Q. Center Console Lid CAUTION Label.
1. Place the CAUTION label (supplied in kit)
on the inside of the center console lid as
shown in Fig. Q−1.
Facial Tissue Holder
Fig. Q−1
i. Remove the facial tissue holder to
provide additional clearance.
R. In Process Functional Test.
1. Temporarily reconnect battery negative (−)
cable.
i. Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when replacing the cable.
2. Turn ignition key to ACC position.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 21 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
3. Press the power button on the DVD Player.
Verify the backlighting illuminates and the
power switch illuminates bright red.
4. Insert a DVD into the DVD player. Verify
that DVD accepts disc.
5. Press the play button on the DVD player.
Verify that DVD video is displayed on the
LCD monitor.
6. Test the Remote Control functions using the
test remote.
i. Press and release the FM
TRANSMITTER ON/OFF button on the
remote control.
ii. Press the SELECT button on the remote
control until 88.3 MHz is displayed on
the LCD monitor.
iii. Tune radio to 88.3 MHz on FM band.
7. Press and release the FM TRANSMITTER
ON/OFF button on the remote control.
Verify that audio from the DVD can be heard
through the vehicle speakers.
8. Using the test wireless headphones verify
that audio from the DVD can be heard
through the headphones.
9. Press the STOP button on the DVD player.
10. Check the FPD display unit dome light
functions.
11. Disconnect battery negative cable.
S. Reassemble the Vehicle.
1. Reinstall all removed panels and parts as per
the following procedure. Be sure that all
panel clips are engaged.
i. Retighten seat belt anchor bolts to
32 lbf−ft.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 22 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section II − Installation Procedure
2. Reconnect the vehicle’s negative battery
cable. (Fig. S−1)
30
10 mm Socket
Torque Wrench
i. Position the negative terminal at an angle
of ~30º to the battery as shown.
ii. Tighten the nut to 4.1 N−m (36 lbf−in).
Negative
Battery Cable
Battery
iii. Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when replacing the cable.
T. Final Preparation.
1. Place the Owner’s Manual in the glove box.
Fig. S−1
2. Place remote control in center console.
3. Refer to PPO wireless headphone instructions
for placement of headphone stickers.
4. Place headphones in rear side pockets.
5. Vacuum debris from floor and seats.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 23 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section III − Functional Verifications
Section III − Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Turn the Ignition Key to the ACC or Run
Position and Turn the Vehicle Radio ON.
Press the power button on the DVD
Verify the backlighting illuminates and the
Player.
power switch illuminates bright red.
Insert a DVD into the DVD Player.
Verify that the DVD accepts disc.
Press the play button on the DVD Player.
Verify that DVD video is displayed on the
LCD monitor.
Press and release the FM TRANSMITTER
Verify that audio from the DVD can be
ON/OFF button on the remote control.
heard through the vehicle speakers.
Press the SELECT button on the remote
control until 88.3 MHz is displayed on the
LCD monitor. Tune radio to 88.3 MHz on
FM band. Press and release the FM
TRANSMITTER ON/OFF button on the
remote control.
Press and release the power button on the
Verify that audio from the DVD can be
test wireless headphones to turn them on.
heard through the headphones.
Press the STOP button on the DVD
Verify that DVD Player switches off.
Player.
Verify that all three dome light switch
Check the FPD display unit Dome Light
positions function correctly.
functions.
Turn the Ignition Key to the OFF Position
and Turn the Vehicle Radio OFF.
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 24 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2004 −
DVD VES
Section III − Functional Verifications
Section III − Functional Verifications
Check:
Look For:
Vehicle Function Checks
Console Map Light
Functioning Map Light
Sunroof (if applicable)
Functioning Sunroof
Vanity Lights (if equipped)
Functioning Vanity Lights
Air Conditioner
Functioning Air Conditioner
Fan
Functioning Fan
Radio Back Light
Functioning Radio Back Light
Cigarette Lighter
Functioning Cigarette Lighter
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
Functioning Cigarette Lighter Illumination
ECT Snow Function (if equipped)
Functioning ECT Indicator Lights
Emergency Flashers
Functioning Emergency Flashers
Seat Heaters (if equipped)
Seat Heater Lights turn on
Glove Box Light
Glove Box Light turns on
Issue: B
10/08/03
Page 25 of 25 pages
Supplier Ref #:
DIO
TOYOTA
Preparation
4RUNNER
2006 -
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Part Number: PT212-89060
Kit Contents
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
1
Description
Skid Plate
Installation Tools
Torque Wrench
Socket
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
4
4
5
6
7
1
2
2
1
8
1
9
2
Description
LH Bracket
RH Bracket
M12 x 1.75 x 20 Course thread
SEMS Head Bolts
DIO Instruction Sheet
M8 Rivnuts
M8 x 25mm Flange Head Bolts
M10 Nut (Discard after Rivn ut
install)
M8 x 45mm SEMS Head Bolt
(Discard after Rivn ut install)
M12 x 1.25 x 25 Fine Thread
Bolts - Serrated Flange Head
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Conflicts
Note:
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
None
Extension
Measuring Rule
Combina tion Wrench
Ratchet
Special Chemicals
None
Notes
½" & 3/8" Drive
17 mm, 12 mm, 13 mm (M8
bolt)
3"
Metric (mm)
15 mm
Notes
General Applicability
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
Accessory
*Mandatory
Vehicle Service Parts (may be requi red for reassembly)
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Legend
Notes
Safety Glasses
Special Tools
SKID PLATE
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
Notes
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Issue: A
07/25/05
Page 1 of 4 pages
TOYOTA
4 RUNNER
Procedure
2006 -
SKID PLATE
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follo w approved guideli nes to ensure a quality inst allation.
These guideli nes can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:-- Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals , etc.).
-- Safety (eye protection, recheckin g torque procedure, etc.).
-- Vehicle Dis assembl y/Reassembl y (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
-- Electrical Component Disassembl y/Reassembl y (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Install Riv Nut
Fig. 1-1
(a) Working under a vehicle requires installer to
wear safety glasses.
M8 Bolt
M10 Nut
M8 Riv nut
15 mm W rench, 12 mm Socket, Ratchet
(b) Remove hardware bag from carton, and
verify content by referring to the instruction
sheet.
(c) Assemble Rivnut, oversize nut (M10), and
M8 x 45 mm bolt together as shown in
Fig. 1-1. Hand tighten the M8 bolt into the
Rivnut and the M10 nut against the Rivnut.
(d) Place the assembly into the non-threaded
upper hole located on the connection brace
between the lower radiator support crossmember and the vehicle's frame above the
tow loop. Ensure that the flange of the
Rivnut is flush against the surface of the hole
as shown in Fig. 1-2.
Fig. 1-2
(e) Hold the assembly in place using a 15 mm
combination wrench on oversize nut as
shown in inset detail (Fig. 1-2).
(f) Use a hand or air ratchet to drive the M8
Flange Head Bolt into the Rivnut. (Fig. 1-2 inset) This will cause the cylinder of the
Rivnut to mushroom against the inner wall of
the frame. You will feel a change in
resistance when the Rivnut is compressed at
which time you can stop. Final torquing
after bracket installation will ensure proper
compression of Rivnut.
Issue: A
07/25/05
Page 2 of 4 pages
TOYOTA
Procedure
4 RUNNER
13 mm, 17 mm Socket
2006 -
SKID PLATE
(g) Remove M8 bolt and oversize nut.
(h) Repeat on other side.
(i) Discard oversize nut and M8 x 45 mm bolt.
2. Installation of Brackets.
Fig. 2-1
(a) Install (hand tight) LH bracket using supplied
M8 and M12 x 1.25 x 25 mm fine thread bolt
as shown in Fig. 2-1.
(b) Repeat for RH bracket.
NOTE: Be sure to use M12 fine thread bolts
in these positions only.
17 mm Socket
3. Installation of Skid Plate.
(a) Remove skid plate from packaging and place
on a protected worktable to avoid damage.
Fig. 3-1
(b) Hold the skid plate up to the brackets and
place M12 course thread SEMS head flange
bolts through skid plate. Thread (hand tight)
the bolts into the weld nuts on the brackets as
shown in Fig. 3-1.
(c) Move skid plate to create a 16 mm min. and
20 mm max. gap between the middle of the
front edge of the skid plate and the bumper.
Fig. 3-2.
(d) Tighten vehicle mounting bolts, torque M8
hardware to 20 lbf-ft (27 N-m) and M12 fine
thread hardware to 60 lbf-ft (81 N-m).
Fig. 3-2
(e) Tighten skid plate mounting M12 flange
bolts to 20 lbf-ft (27 N-m).
Issue: A
07/25/05
Page 3 of 4 pages
TOYOTA
4 RUNNER
2006 -
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
SKID PLATE
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Visual check of skid plate
Gap to vehicle bumper (16 mm min./20 mm
max.).
Symmetric gap between bumper fascia and
skid plate on right and left sides.
Check all bracket bolts for proper torque
with torque wrench.
(Note: Do not perform check of M12
flange bolts on Skid Plate).
Issue: A
07/25/05
Page 4 of 4 pages
Tightening torques have a range of ±25%.
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
General Applicability
Part Number: 08586-3D892
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
1
Description
Wire Harness
V2 Security ECU
Microphone
Owner’s Guide
Note: 4Runner with factory TDS system, only.
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
*Mandatory
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
2
5
5
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Description
ECU Mounting Bracket
Butyl Tape
Bolt
Small Foam Tape Strips
Medium Wire Ties
Large Wire Ties
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Conflicts
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Safety Glasses
Safety Gloves
Vehicle Protection
Optional
Blankets, Part Boxes
Notes
Striker Tool (PPO only)
CAD-E IADE P/N
ALL 02-016-01
Installation Tools
Notes
Screwdriver
Screwdriver
Screwdriver
Wrench
Socket
Ratchet
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
Phillips Head, #2
Small, Flat Blade
Flat Blade, Jeweler’s
Pneumatic/Electric
10 mm
e.g. Panel Pry Tool #1
Toyota SST # 00002-06001-1
Torque Wrench
Pliers
Cloth
Side Cutter Tool
36 lbf-in
Needle Nose
Lint-free
Special Chemicals
Notes
Cleaner
Issue: C
10/05/05
Description
Center Cluster Panel Clips
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Notes
Special Tools
Quantity Reqd.
4
Legend
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Accessory
V2
3MTM Prep Solvent-70
Page 1 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:-- Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
-- Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
-- Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
-- Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Vehicle Disassembly.
10mm Wrench
Battery
Negative Battery
Cable
(a) For vehicles equipped with automatic
transmission, place the shifter in low gear
and set the parking brake prior to
disconnecting the battery.
(b) Remove the negative battery cable.
(Fig. 1-1)
Fig. 1-1
(1) Protect the fender before starting.
(2) Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when removing cable.
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
(c) Remove the passenger side step cover.
(Fig. 1-2)
(1) Cover the floor and seats before starting.
Step Cover
Fig. 1-2
(d) Remove the passenger side cowl cover.
(Fig. 1-3)
(1) Remove the nut securing the cover.
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
Nut
Fig. 1-3
Issue: C
Cowl Cover
10/05/05
Page 2 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
(e) Remove the glove box assembly. (Fig. 1-4)
Phillips Screwdriver
Damper
Screw
(1) Remove the screw securing the glove box
assembly.
(2) Remove the glove box damper.
(f) Remove the cover from the upper glove box
area. (Fig. 1-5)
Fig. 1-4
(1) Remove the four screws securing the
cover.
Glove Box
Phillips Screwdriver
Screws (x2)
Air Bag
Connector
Holder
Screws (x2)
(2) Remove the air bag connector holder
from the cover.
(g) Remove the under-dash cover below the
glove box area. (Fig. 1-6)
(1) Remove the one screw securing the cover.
(2) Disconnect the two connectors of the
4WD control ECU (if equipped) and one
connector of the tire pressure monitor
ECU. Then remove the one vehicle wire
harness clip.
Cover
Fig. 1-5
Phillips Screwdriver
(h) Remove the center cluster panel. (Fig. 1-7)
(1) Remove the one screw securing the panel.
(2) Disconnect all connectors from the panel.
Under-Dash Cover
Clip
Fig. 1-6
Screw
Phillips Screwdriver
Nylon Panel
Removal Tool
Center Cluster
Panel
Fig. 1-7
Issue: C
Screw
10/05/05
Page 3 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
2. V2 ECU Preparation and Installation.
(a) Prepare a protective sheet (blanket), and
cover the blower assembly in the glove box
area with the sheet as shown. (Fig. 2-1)
(b) Turn the adjustment screw on the V2 ECU to
the “9” position. (Fig. 2-2)
Fig. 2-1
(c) Insert the V2 ECU mounting bracket into the
indicated bracket slot on the V2 ECU.
(Fig. 2-3)
Protective Sheet
Small Flat Blade Screwdriver
(1) Insert the mounting bracket into the
correct slot; you have only one chance to
install it properly.
V2 ECU
(2) Make sure the bracket is firmly attached
to the ECU.
(d) Apply the butyl tape to the V2 ECU as
shown. (Fig. 2-3)
Fig. 2-2
Butyl Tape
(e) Locate and remove the existing bolt from the
connector block in the passenger side cowl
area. (Fig. 2-4)
(1) Discard the existing bolt.
V2 ECU
Mounting
Bracket
Fig. 2-3
10 mm Socket
V2 ECU
Existing
Bolt
Connector
Block
Fig. 2-4
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 4 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
10 mm Socket
V2 ECU
Bolt
(Supplied)
(f) Mount the V2 ECU on the right side of the
connector block with the bolt supplied in the
kit. (Fig. 2-5)
3. V2 Wire Harness Installation.
(a) Plug the V2 harness' white 8P connector into
the V2 ECU. (Fig. 3-1)
Fig. 2-5
(1) Verify the connector is plugged in
securely.
V2 ECU
V2 Harness
8P (White)
Fig. 3-1
(b) Secure the V2 harness to the vehicle harness
with one medium wire tie and one small
foam tape strip. (Fig. 3-2)
(c) Route the V2 harness toward the upper glove
box area, and secure it to the vehicle harness
with one large wire tie and one medium wire
tie. (Fig. 3-3)
Side Cutter
V2 Harness
Medium Wire Tie
Fig. 3-2
Side Cutter
Medium Wire Tie
Large Wire Tie
Fig. 3-3
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 5 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
Pliers, Needle Nose
Wire Clip
(1) Remove the vehicle wire clip on the
center brace and open the vehicle wire
clip.
V2 Harness
Fig. 3-4
(2) Route the V2 wire harness though the
open vehicle wire clip.
40P (White)
V2 Harness
(3) Close and reinstall the vehicle wire clip
to the center brace.
Vehicle Security
ECU
Fig. 3-5
Jeweler's Screwdriver
40P (White)
V2 Harness’
YELLOW Wire
(e) Locate the vehicle security ECU's white 40P
connector in the upper left side of the glove
box area, and disconnect it. (Fig. 3-5)
(f) Using a small jeweler's screwdriver, lift up
the terminal retainer on the back of the white
40P connector. (Fig. 3-6)
(1) Do not pull out the retainer.
(g) Insert the terminal at the end of the V2
harness' YELLOW wire into the top row,
tenth space from the left of the white 40P
connector, then close the retainer. (Fig. 3-6)
Retainer
Fig. 3-6
(d) Route the V2 harness toward the left side of
the glove box area, and secure it to the
vehicle harness with the existing vehicle wire
clip. (Fig. 3-4)
(1) Turn the connector so the wires face you
and the tab is on top.
WIRE SIDE VIEW
(2) Verify the correct opening is chosen.
Side Cutter
40P (White)
Medium Wire Ties (x3)
V2 Harness
Microphone
Wire
Fig. 3-7
Issue: C
Vehicle Security
ECU
10/05/05
(3) Verify the terminal is inserted and seated
properly. The terminal should not come
out when pulled lightly from the back. If
the terminal comes off, push it in again.
(h) Reconnect the white 40P connector to the
vehicle security ECU. (Fig. 3-7)
(i) Secure the V2 harness’ microphone wire to
the vehicle harness with three medium wire
ties. (Fig. 3-7)
Page 6 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
(1) Bundle and secure the excess V2 harness’
YELLOW wire in the top wire tie.
Side Cutter
Large Wire
Ties (x3)
(j) Secure the V2 harness to the vehicle harness
with three large wire ties. (Fig. 3-8)
V2 Harness
(k) Route the V2 harness toward the center
cluster panel area. (Fig. 3-9)
(l) Plug the V2 harness' white 14P male
connector into the vehicle harness white 14P
female connector. (Fig. 3-10)
Fig. 3-8
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
(m) Secure the V2 harness to the vehicle harness
with one large wire tie. (Fig. 3-11)
14P (White)
V2 Harness
Fig. 3-9
(1) Connect the V2 harness’ white 14P
female connector to the center cluster
panel during reassembly of the vehicle.
Vehicle ‘s 14P (White)
14P (White)
V2 Harness
Fig. 3-10
Side Cutter
Large Wire Tie
14P (White)
V2 Harness
Fig. 3-11
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 7 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
4. Microphone Installation.
(a) Using 3MTM Prep Solvent-70, clean the area
indicated on the back side of the under-dash
cover. (Fig. 4-1)
Large Hole
Under-dash Cover
45˚
Microphone
Fig. 4-1
Insulator
(1) Always use a clean (lint free scratch
resistant) soft cloth (or wipe), and clean a
small area at a time (~ 3 ft. x 3 ft. max.).
(2) Shake well.
(3) Apply 3MTM Prep Solvent-70 to cloth or
wipe. Do not spray cleaning solution
directly on any vehicle surfaces.
(4) Clean surface thoroughly and wipe dry
immediately with a new clean cloth. Do
not allow cleaner to air dry.
(c) Remove the backing sheet and secure the
microphone to the back side of the underdash cover. (Fig. 4-1)
2P (White)
V2 Harness
Small Foam Tape
Microphone
Fig. 4-2
Under-Dash Cover
(1) Secure the microphone under the
insulator at a 45˚ angle with the back of
the microphone lined up with the front
edge of the large hole as shown.
(Fig. 4-1)
(2) Do not touch the adhesive surface of the
microphone.
(3) Press the microphone to the under-dash
cover firmly.
(d) Plug in the microphone's 2P connector to the
V2 harness’ 2P connector. (Fig. 4-2)
(1) Verify the connectors are plugged in
securely.
(e) Wrap the 2P connectors with a small foam
tape strip. (Fig. 4-2)
(f) Reinstall the under-dash cover. (Fig. 4-2)
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 8 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006-
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Procedure
5. Completing the Installation.
(a) Complete the reassembly of the vehicle.
Torque Wrench, 10 mm Socket
(1) Reconnect any disconnected connectors.
30˚
Negative Battery
Cable
(2) Verify the panels fit together properly
with no uneven gaps between them.
(b) Clean up and remove any trash.
(c) Reconnect the vehicle’s negative battery
cable. (Fig. 5-1)
Battery
Fig. 5-1
(1) Position the negative terminal at an angle
of 30˚ to the battery as shown, or to the
original factory installed angle.
(2) Tighten the nut to 4.1 N-m (36 lbf-in).
(3) Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when replacing the cable.
(4) Reattach the negative battery cable clip.
(d) Place the owner’s manual, left in the
protective bag, in the glove box.
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 9 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Fit appropriate fuse before beginning.
Close the hood before beginning.
Press and release the remote control’s lock
button to start the system’s arming process.
1. The turn signal lights flash once.
The buzzer chirps once.
All doors lock.
The Immobilizer System's LED lights up.
Wait 30 seconds.
2. After 30 seconds, the LED starts flashing;
the system is now armed.
Perform the following check in a
temperature controlled environment
(500-900).
With the tip of key (or Striker Tool pulled
all the way out (PPO only)), tap the center
of the driver's door window to trigger the
"warn away" alarm.
3. The horn sounds repeatedly.
The interior lights turn on.
The headlights flash repeatedly.
The turn signal lights flash repeatedly.
The Security LED lights up.
NOTE: Adjust as necessary by increasing the
GBS setting to the next level if the alarm does
not trigger during the functional verifications.
NOTE: If you do not disarm the system, the
alarm will last 20 seconds. It is not necessary
to check the alarm duration.
Insert the key into the driver’s door key
cylinder and turn it toward the back of the
vehicle to stop the alarm.
Issue: C
10/05/05
4. The horn stops sounding.
All the lights stop flashing.
The status monitor’s LED lights up.
The driver’s door unlocks.
Page 10 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Vehicle Function Checks
Head Lights
Functioning Head Lights
High Beams
Functioning High Beams
Turn Signal Lights
Functioning Turn Signal Lights
Tail Lights
Functioning Tail Lights
Stop Lights
Functioning Stop Lights
Backup Lights
Functioning Backup Lights
Hazard Lights
Functioning Hazard Lights
Marker Lights
Functioning Marker Lights
Dome/Courtesy Lights
Functioning Dome/Courtesy Lights
Panel/Switch Illumination
Functioning Controls/Illumination
Accessory Controls/Illumination (if
Functioning Accessory Controls
equipped)
Key Sensor Buzzer
Functioning Key Sensor
Fog Lights (if equipped)
Functioning Fog Lights
Daytime Running Lights (if equipped)
Functioning DR Lights
Trunk/Tailgate/Bed Lights (if equipped)
Functioning Lights
Glove Box Light (if equipped)
Functioning Glove Box Light
Cruise Control Light (if equipped)
Functioning Cruise Control Light
Seat Belt Warning Light
Functioning Seat Belt Warning Light. If the
warning light remains “ON”, it may
indicate a system malfunction.
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 11 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Air Bag
Functioning Air Bag Warning Light. If the
warning light remains “ON”, it may
indicate a system malfunction.
ABS Light (if equipped)
Functioning ABS Light. If warning light
remains “ON”, it may indicate a system
malfunction.
Lamp Failure Sensor (if equipped)
Functioning Lamp Failure Sensor. If the
warning light remains “ON”, it may
indicate a system malfunction.
Track/ Skid Control Light (if equipped)
Functioning Track/ VSC Light. If the
warning light remains “ON”, it may
indicate a system malfunction.
HVAC
Functioning HVAC Controls
Power Locks (if equipped)
Functioning Power Locks
Power Windows (if equipped)
Functioning Power Windows
Power Seats (if equipped)
Functioning Power Seats
Power Sunroof (if equipped)
Functioning Sunroof
Horn
Functioning Horn
Gauges
Functioning Gauges
Front Wiper/Washer (if equipped)
Functioning Front Wiper/Washer
Rear Wiper/Washer (if equipped)
Functioning Rear Wiper/Washer
Clock (if equipped)
Functioning Clock
Accessory Power Socket (if equipped)
Functioning Accessory Power Socket
Starter
Functioning Starter
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 12 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
TVIP V2 (GBS ADD-ON)
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Audio/Video (if equipped)
Functioning Audio/Video
Power Sliding Door (if equipped)
Functioning Sliding Door
Convenience Memory Setting (if equipped)
Functioning Convenience Memory Setting
Heated Seats (if equipped)
Functioning Seats
Massage Seats (if equipped)
Functioning Massage Seats
Rear Window Defogger (if equipped)
Functioning Rear Window Defogger
Side Mirror Defogger (if equipped)
Functioning Side Mirror Defogger
Front Windshield Defogger (if equipped)
Functioning Front Windshield Defogger
Navigation System (if equipped)
Functioning Navigation System
Tire Pressure Monitor
Functioning Tire Pressure Monitor
Passenger Occupant Air Bag Light
Functioning Passenger Occupant Air Bag
Light
Remove the appropriate fuse after
checks completed.
Issue: C
10/05/05
Page 13 of 13 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
EXHAUST
Installation Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Part Number: PTR31-89060
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
Item #
1
Description
Front Muffler Assembly
Rear Tailpipe Assembly
Hardware Bag
Quantity Reqd.
1
Description
Front Flange Gasket PN:
17451-74051 – DIO ONLY
2
3
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
1
2
3
2
4
4
5
1
Legend
Description
Gasket 23000-00035
M10x1.5x35 mm long
Hex Head Bolts
M10x1.5
Hex Nuts
M10
Flat Washers
Installation Instructions
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
Quantity Reqd.
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Description
Conflicts
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
None
Special Tools
Notes
Exhaust Hanger Removal
Tool
e.g. Snap On P/N YA3202
Installation Tools
Notes
Socket
Wrenches
Torque Wrench
14 mm, 16 mm, 17 mm
14 mm, 16 mm, 17 mm
50 lbf.ft
Special Chemicals
Notes
Lubricant
Soap and Water
General Applicability
2006MY V6 4Runner: PTR31-89060
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
Accessory
*Mandatory
Issue: A
03/01/06
Page 1 of 6 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
EXHAUST
Installation Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:-- Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
-- Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
-- Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
-- Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Check the Kit content.
Converter Assembly
(a) Make sure that the kit contains all the parts
listed in the Kit Contents.
Spring
14 mm Socket
Muffler
Assembly
(a) Using the 14mm socket, remove two bolts
with springs from front flange located
between catalytic converter and rear muffler.
(Fig. 2-1)
Gasket Location
Bolt
Fig. 2-1
Rear tailpipe assembly
2. Remove Existing Exhaust System.
Bolt
(b) Keep all original equipment (OE) bolts and
springs. (Fig. 2-1)
(1) Ensure that the original gasket remains
on converter assembly flange
14 mm
Socket
Bolt
NOTE: For DIO, installation gasket must be
replaced – P/N 17451-74051.
Front
Muffler
Assembly
Fig. 2-2
Rubber hanger
Exhaust Hanger
Removal Tool
(c) Using the 14mm socket, remove and discard
two bolts from rear flange located between
muffler assembly and rear tailpipe assembly.
(Fig 2-2)
Tailpipe
(d) Pry the rear tailpipe exhaust bracket loose
from the rubber hanger located near the rear
bumper. (Fig. 2-3)
Bracket
(e) Remove the OE rear tailpipe assembly from
the vehicle.
Fig. 2-3
Issue: A
03/01/06
Page 2 of 6 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
EXHAUST
Installation Procedure
(f) Pry the two front muffler exhaust brackets
loose from the rubber hangers. (Fig. 2-4)
Rubber Hanger
Exhaust Hanger
Removal Tool
Bracket
Bracket
Rubber Hanger
Fig. 2-4
(g) Pry the two rear muffler exhaust brackets
loose from the rubber hangers. (Fig 2-5)
Exhaust Hanger
Removal Tool
NOTE: Use of lubrication (such as “soap and
water”) on the rubber exhaust hangers can
facilitate removal and installation of rubber
hangers.
Rubber
Hanger
Bracket
Bracket
Rubber Hanger
Fig. 2-5
(h) Do not remove the five (5) original (OE)
rubber hangers from the vehicle.
(i) Remove the OE front muffler assembly from
the vehicle.
Rubber Hanger
3. Installation of TRD Exhaust System.
(a) Connect the two front muffler hangers of the
TRD muffler assembly to OE rubber
hangers. (Fig. 3-1)
Bracket
Bracket
Fig. 3-1
Issue: A
Rubber Hanger
03/01/06
Page 3 of 6 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
EXHAUST
Installation Procedure
(b) Connect the two rear muffler hangers to OE
rubber hangers. (Fig. 3-2)
Rubber
Hanger
Bracket
Bracket
Rubber Hanger
Fig. 3-2
Rubber hanger
Tailpipe
(c) Connect TRD tailpipe hanger to OE rubber
hanger. (Fig. 3-3)
(d) Make sure TRD muffler front flange is lined
up to converter assembly flange.
(e) Make sure rear flange between front muffler
assembly and rear tailpipe assembly is lined
up.
Bracket
Fig. 3-3
Converter Assembly
Spring
Torque Wrench
14 mm Socket
Muffler
Assembly
(g) Tighten bolts to 32 lbf-ft (43N-m) (Fig. 3-4).
Gasket Location
Bolt
Fig. 3-4
Issue: A
(f) Install muffler front flange to connect to OE
front converter assembly. Reinstall two (2)
OE springs and bolts evenly for proper
flange alignment. (Fig. 3-4)
03/01/06
Page 4 of 6 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
EXHAUST
Installation Procedure
(h) Install supplied gasket P/N 23000-00035 on
the rear flange of the muffler. (Fig. 3.5)
Torque Wrench, 16 & 17 mm Socket & Wrench
Rear Tailpipe
Assembly
Washer
(x2)
Nut
Gasket
Location
Bolt
Washer
(x2)
(i) Connect the rear tailpipe assembly to the
muffler rear flange and securely fasten the
flange connection, using bolts and nuts
supplied in the kit. (Fig. 3-5)
Nut
Front
Muffler
Assembly
Fig. 3-5
(1) Using the 16 & 17mm socket & wrench,
install two supplied washers between the
bolts and the upper flange, and two
washers between the nuts and the lower
flange.
(j) Tighten bolts to 25 lbf-ft (34N-m) (Fig. 3-4).
Issue: A
03/01/06
Page 5 of 6 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2007 -
EXHAUST
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Correct part has been installed.
Verify part number on package.
All joints have been securely fastened.
Verify joints are tightened.
Hooks/hangers have been securely
Verify hooks/hangers are securely attached.
reattached.
Start the vehicle.
Verify the flange joints do not have
abnormal leak sound or water leak.
Vehicle Function Checks
Inspection torque - muffler to converter
assembly.
32+/- 5 lbf-ft (43 +/- 6 N-m).
Inspection torque – tailpipe assembly to
outlet flange.
Issue: A
03/01/06
25+/- 5 lbf-ft (34 +/- 6 N-m).
Page 6 of 6 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Part Number: PT228-89460
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
Description
High Assembly
Wiring Harness Bracket
Hardware Bag
Hitch Cover
Frame Spacer
Center Spacer
Close-out Panel
Quantity Reqd.
4
2
4
3
4
4
2
5
2
6
1
Description
M12 x 1.25 x 45 Hex Flange
Bolt (Black)
M12 x 1.25 x 35 Hex Flange
Bolt (Black)
M8 x 1.25 x 25 Bolt w/Trapped
Washer (Black)
M8 x 1.25 x 20 Bolt w/Trapped
Washer (Black)
M6 x 1.00 x 20 hex Flange Bolt
(Black)
Harness Clamp/Cable tie
Description
Note:
Notes
Safety Glasses
Vehicle Protection
Cloth (Shop Towel)
Special Tools
Notes
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
*Mandatory
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Item #
1
2
3
Notes
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
e.g. Panel Pry Tool #1
Toyota SST # 00002-06001-01
Ratchets
Sockets (Deep Well)
Socket Wrench
Extensions
Issue: C
07/06/05
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Legend
None
Installation Tools
Accessory
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Conflicts
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
Note: All V-8 4-Runner vehicles
Additional Items Required For Installation
Quantity Reqd.
Special Chemicals
General Applicability
(P/N 82711-16830)
Item #
1
2
0-100 lbf-ft, 0-100 lbf-in
e.g. Snap On P/N YA3202
None
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
Torque Wrench (x2)
Exhaust Hanger Removal
Tool
½" and ⅜"
10 mm, 12 mm, 13 mm,
17 mm
6" min.
Page 1 of 7 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Inspection.
(a) Inspect parts for damage.
2. Prepare Vehicle for Hitch Installation.
(a) Cover exhaust pipe with clean shop towel.
(Fig. 2-1).
(b) Caution muffler may be sharp and or hot.
Fig. 2-1
Vehicle Frame
(c) Remove and save tie-down. Discard the two
(2) bolts removed from the vehicle.
(Fig. 2-2)
Fig. 2-2
Exhaust Hanger Removal Tool
(d) Lower exhaust by disconnecting the rubber
exhaust hanger from one of the connection
points. (Fig. 2-3)
Fig. 2-3
Issue: C
07/06/05
Page 2 of 7 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Procedure
Nylon Panel Removal Tool
(e) For vehicles equipped with air suspension,
loosen the air suspension cover by removing
the plastic fastener. Save fastener for
reinstallation. (Fig. 2-4)
Fig. 2-4
Panel Pry Tool
(f) Using panel pry tool, unclip harness from the
frame. Install harness clamp close to harness
connector (around black wrap). Secure
harness to frame and trim excess on cable tie.
(Fig. 2-5)
Fig. 2-5
Socket, 12 mm
(g) Remove the two (2) M8 bolts securing the
factory wiring bracket to the frame. Discard
the two (2) bolts. (Fig. 2-6)
Fig. 2-6
(h) Remove the two (2) M6 bolts connecting the
7-pin plug to the bracket, slide the plug from
the bracket. Discard the bolts and factory
wiring bracket. (Fig. 2-7)
Fig. 2-7
Issue: C
07/06/05
Page 3 of 7 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Procedure
3. Attach Hitch Center to Vehicle.
Socket, 17 mm, Extension 6”
Spacer Plates
Closeout
Panel
(a) Install closeout panel and (2) spacer plates to
center attachment bracket by hand starting
(2) M12-1.25x45 black bolts through
closeout panel and spacer plates into forward
most set of holes. (Fig. 3-1)
(b) Slide hitch onto pre-installed bolts using
open ended slots to support the hitch.
(Fig. 3-1)
Fig. 3-1
(c) Hand start two (2) M12-1.25x45 black bolts
to rear most position to secure the hitch and
spacer plates using a socket extension and a
17mm socket. Bolts can be fed through
chain holes. Do not tighten. (Fig. 3-1)
4. Install 7-Pin Wire Harness to Hitch.
Socket, 10 mm, 12mm; Torque Wrench
(a) Install 7-pin wiring harness (removed in
Step B. 8.) to the provided wiring bracket
using two (2) M6-1.00x20mm bolts.
(Fig. 4-1)
(b) Install wiring bracket to inside surface of the
driver side hitch bracket using two (2)
M8x1.25x20 black bolts with trapped
washers. (Fig. 4-1)
Fig. 4-1
(c) Be sure to feed wiring between the hitch tube
and the vehicle cross member.
(d) Tighten the M8 bolts to 19 ± 4 lbf•ft
(25 ± 5 N•m). (Fig. 4-1)
(e) Tighten M6 bolts to 94 ± 19 lbf•in
(10.4 ± 2 N•m). (Fig. 4-1)
5. Place Frame Spacers.
(a) Place frame spacers between hitch brackets
and vehicle frame. (Fig. E-1)
Fig. 3-1
Issue: C
07/06/05
Page 4 of 7 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Procedure
6. Install Hitch to Frame Rail.
(a) Reinstall tie-down bracket to hitch using two
(2) M12 x 1.25x35 black bolts in driver side
rear most frame locations. (Fig. 6-1, Step 1)
(b) Secure hitch to frame using two (2) M12 x
1.25x35 black bolts in passenger side rear
most frame locations. (Fig. 6-1, Step 2)
(c) Hand start four (4) M8 x 1.25 x 25 black
bolts in forward most frame locations.
(Fig. 6-1, Step 3)
Fig. 6-1
(d) Ensure all bolts engage frame spacers and the
spacers do not impede on frame welds.
7. Visually Center Hitch
(a) Visually center hitch so that closeout panel is
centered in fascia cut out. (Fig. 7-1)
Fig. 7-1
8. Tighten Remaining Hitch Hardware.
Socket, 13 mm, 17 mm; Torque Wrench
(a) Tighten four (4) M12 bolts in the center to
60 ± 12 lbf-ft (80 ± 15 N-m).
(Fig. H-1, Steps 1 - 4)
(b) Tighten four (4) M12 bolts on the frame rail
to 60 ± 12 lbf-ft (80 ± 15 N-m).
(Fig. H-1, Steps 5 - 8).
(c) Tighten four (4) M8 bolts to 19 ± 4 lbf-ft
(25 ± 5 N-m). (Fig. H-1, Steps 9 - 12)
Fig. 8-1
Issue: C
07/06/05
Page 5 of 7 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Procedure
9. Reinstall Vehicle Components.
Exhaust Hanger Removal Tool
(a) Reconnect exhaust to the exhaust hanger
ensuring to fully engage the hanger.
(Fig. 9-1)
Fig. 9-1
(b) Reinstall the air suspension cover by
replacing the one fastener. (Fig. 9-2)
(1) If fastener is damaged fit a new fastener,
(P/N 90467-09185).
(c) Place the hitch plug in the glove box.
Fig. 9-2
Issue: C
07/06/05
Page 6 of 7 pages
TOYOTA
4-RUNNER
2006 -
TOWING HITCH
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Inspection torque (M12 bolts)
60 ± 12 lbf-ft (80 ± 15 N-m)
Inspection torque (M8 bolts)
19 ± 4 lbf-ft (25 ± 5 N-m)
Inspection torque (M6 bolts, 7-pin to
94 ± 19 lbf-in (10.4 ± 2 N-m)
bracket)
Frame Spacers
Installed and off of welds
Wiring Bracket
Installed and fed between hitch and cross
member.
Hitch Plug
Issue: C
07/06/05
Placed in glove box
Page 7 of 7 pages
2005-
4RUNNER
TVIP V2
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR (GBS)
OWNER’S GUIDE
G.B.S. TVIP
(GLASS
SENSOR) ENHANCEMENT
2004-2005 PRIUS
V2BREAKAGE
GLASS BREAKAGE
SENSOR (GBS)
DESIGNED FOR USE WITH YOUR VEHICLE’S
OWNER'S GUIDE
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OWNERS GUIDE
The G.B.S. (GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR) provides protection for your vehicle above and beyond the entry
point monitoring performed by the TDS (Theft Deterrent System)—it “listens” for the noise made by tapping on,
or breaking of glass, and triggers alarms upon detection of these types of noise. Using a microphone designed
VSHFL¿FDOO\IRUWKLVWDVNWKH*%6LVFDSDEOHRILJQRULQJRWKHUQRLVHVZKLFKKHOSVSUHYHQW³IDOVHDODUPV´IURP
occurring. (See reverse for descriptions of alarms.)
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR CHECK PROCEDURE
:KHQWKH*%6ZDVLQVWDOOHGLQ\RXUYHKLFOHFDUHZDVWDNHQWRDGMXVWWKHVHQVLWLYLW\OHYHOSURSHUO\\RXPD\
REVHUYHKRZLWZRUNVIROORZLQJWKHSURFHGXUHOLVWHGEHORZ
1.
Arm the theft deterrent system.
Press the lock button on the remote control or
ORFNWKHGRRUVZLWKWKHNH\ 5HPHPEHUWKHV\VWHPZLOO
not arm if any door, or the trunk, is open.)
:DLWXQWLOWKH6HFXULW\/('VWDUWVÀDVKLQJ
7KH/('ZLOOEHJLQWRÀDVKVHFRQGVDIWHUWKHODVW
door or the trunk is closed.
Please note, your vehicle’s Security LED may look
different than the one pictured here.
:LWKWKHWLSRIDNH\WDSWKHFHQWHURIWKHGULYHU¶V
GRRUZLQGRZ
7DSWKHJODVVZLWKOLJKWWRPRGHUDWHIRUFH
:$51,1* 'RQRWKLWWKHJODVVZLWKH[FHVVLYHIRUFH
HVSHFLDOO\LQFROGZHDWKHURU\RXPD\
crack or break it.
4.
A WARN AWAY ALARM should be triggered. (See re
verse for details.) If the ALARM IS not triggered, make
sure you performed the procedure correctly and try
DJDLQ,IWKHV\VWHPGLGQRWSHUIRUPDV\RXH[SHFWHG
contact your Toyota dealer for more information.
Disarm the theft deterrent system to stop the WARN
AWAY ALARM. Press the unlock button on the
remote control, or use the key to unlock a door, to
disarm the system.
Please note, your remote controls may look different
than the one pictured here.
5HY$
GBS ADD-ON
OWNERS GUIDE
Please note, your remote controls may look different
than the one pictured here.
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM DESCRIPTIONS
WARN-AWAY ALARM
Upon initial detection of noise from tapping on, or breaking glass, the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR triggers a
WARN AWAY ALARM:
7KHKRUQVRXQGVUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHKHDGOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHWDLODQGPDUNHUOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHLQWHULRUOLJKWVWXUQRQIRUVHFRQGV
If the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR detects noise again, or if a door or the trunk is forcibly opened, the regular
DODUP GHVFULEHGEHORZ LVDFWLYDWHG
REGULAR ALARM
:KHQDQDODUPLVWULJJHUHGLQDQ\ZD\RWKHUWKDQLQLWLDOGHWHFWLRQE\WKH*/$66%5($.$*(6(1625WKHIRO
ORZLQJRFFXUV
7KHKRUQVRXQGVUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHKHDGOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHWDLODQGPDUNHUOLJKWVÀDVKUHSHDWHGO\IRUVHFRQGV
7KHLQWHULRUOLJKWVWXUQRQIRUVHFRQGV
$Q\GRRUORFNZLOOEHUHORFNHGLIVRPHRQHUHDFKHVLQDQGXQORFNVDQLQVLGHORFNEXWWRQ$IWHUVHF
RQGVWKHWKHIWGHWHUUHQWV\VWHPZLOOUHDUPDQGFRQWLQXHWRSURWHFWWKHYHKLFOH
STOPPING AN ALARM
6LPSO\GLVDUPWKHWKHIWGHWHUUHQWV\VWHPXVLQJWKHUHPRWHFRQWURORUNH\DVGHVFULEHGLQWKH2ZQHU¶V*XLGHIRU
your vehicle.
2003 4 RUNNER
TVIP V5
RS3200 PLUS
OWNER’S GUIDE
RS3200 PLUS
SECURITY SYSTEM
DESIGNED FOR USE WITH YOUR VEHICLE’S
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM
OWNER’S GUIDE
Rev. A 09/24/02
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 1
To better understand the features and functions of this security system, please read this Owner’s
Guide completely prior to use.
For
N
m
d
ock
r
on
w
TABLE OF CONTENTS
DESCRIPTION
INTRODUCTION
BRIEF DESCRIPTION–RS3200 PLUS FEATURES
OPERATION
ARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE ARMING)
DISARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE DISARMING)
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC) ARMING & DISARMING
AUTOMATIC REARMING
ARMING SUSPENSION
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM TRIGGERS
ALARM DESCRIPTIONS
STOPPING AN ALARM
PAGE
2
3, 4
5
6
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR INFORMATION
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR CHECK PROCEDURE
11
PROGRAMMING
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC) ARMING AND ENTRY DELAY
(Not applicable to Highlander and Sienna. Please consult your
Toyota Dealer for programming information.)
WARNING and CAUTION INFORMATION
12
13
Page 2
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
INTRODUCTION
GLASS BREAKA
Congratulations on your choice of the RS3200 PLUS add-on security system to protect your vehicle!
To get the most from the system, we strongly recommend that you read this Owner’s Guide completely to learn all of its features and functions.
The RS3200 PLUS provides security through point-of-entry monitoring, glass breakage detection and
ignition switch monitoring. While ARMED, the system will be TRIGGERED and sound an ALARM when a
door, trunk or hatch is forcibly unlocked or opened*, or when a window is tapped on or broken.
During the ALARM, the vehicle’s horn sounds and the headlights, tail lights and front marker or turn
signal lights flash. A l s o , the vehicle’s starter is disabled, preventing engine start. In addition to the
comprehensive protection, the RS3200 PLUS works in conjunction with your vehicle’s remote keyless entry system, enabling you to ARM and DISARM the security system at the same time the doors
are remotely locked and unlocked. In vehicles equipped with a buzzer, it will chirp when the system
is REMOTE ARMED and DISARMED.
The RS3200 PLUS provides pro
“listens” for the noise made by
specifically for this task, the GL
helps to prevent “false alarms”
GLASS BREAKAGE SE
When the RS3200 PLUS was in
of the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSO
below.
1.
An important note about your system
➀➁
Throughout this guide, there are references to the STATUS MONITOR for this system. Illustrated
below, this panel holds the LED indicator (for the system’s operating status) and the GLASS
BREAKAGE SENSOR’S microphone. In vehicles equipped with an engine immobilizer system, there is
a LED already installed, so the RS3200 PLUS utilizes the vehicle’s engine immobilizer system LED➂
instead and a microphone mounted in a separate location. If your vehicle falls into this category,
remember to look at that LED when the information refers to the STATUS MONITOR. If you do not
know where the LED is located, refer to your vehicle’s owner’s guide for specific information.
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PREARMING)
THEN
STARTS
FLASHING
(SYSTEM
IS
ARMED)
➁
2.
➂
YOUR ENGINE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM LED MAY LOOK
DIFFERENT THAN THE ONE
ILLUSTRATED HERE
3.
* When the system is PASSIVELY (AUTOMATICALLY) ARMED, there is an ENTRY DELAY that will elapse
when a door is opened before an ALARM is TRIGGERED.
4.
OR,
H
S
tem
GH
S
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 3
BRIEF DESCRIPTION–RS3200 PLUS FEATURES
FEATURES
FUNCTIONS
The RS3200 PLUS will ARM 30 seconds after the lock button on the remote
REMOTE
keyless entry system’s remote control is pressed, and DISARM when the
ARMING/DISARMING
unlock button is pressed. If your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer that chirps
when the lock and unlock buttons on the remote controls are pressed, the
buzzer will also chirp when the system is REMOTE ARMED and DISARMED.
The RS3200 PLUS will automatically REARM at the same time the
AUTOMATIC
vehicle’s remote keyless entry system relocks the vehicle’s
REARMING
doors, if no door is opened within 30 seconds after REMOTE DISARMING.
The RS3200 PLUS will ARM 30 seconds after you close the trunk (if
KEY
open) and lock the vehicle’s doors with the key, and will DISARM when
ARMING/DISARMING
you unlock a door with the key.
While ARMED, the trunk may be opened with the key (or trunk release button
ARMED MODE
SUSPENSION**
on your remote control, if so equipped) without TRIGGERING an ALARM. Once
the open trunk is closed, the system ARMS again.
The RS3200 PLUS may be programmed to automatically ARM 30
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC)
seconds
after the ignition key is removed, the vehicle exited and the
ARMING
last door and the trunk closed, without the necessity of locking doors.
The RS3200 PLUS may be DISARMED with the vehicle’s ignition key
PASSIVE DISARMING
after it was PASSIVELY ARMED.
ADJUSTABLE ENTRY
When the RS3200 PLUS has been PASSIVELY ARMED, an ENTRY DELAY
DELAY
(user-selectable at 0, 15, or 30 seconds) will start when a door is
opened before an ALARM is TRIGGERED.
When you lock the vehicle with the central lock switch (while a door
MANUAL ARMING
is open), the RS3200 PLUS will ARM 30 seconds after you close all
the doors and the trunk (if open).
The RS3200 PLUS may be DISARMED by inserting the key into the
IGNITION KEY
ignition switch and turning it to “ON.”
DISARMING
Forcibly unlocking or opening a door or trunk while the RS3200 PLUS
POINT-OF-ENTRY
is ARMED will TRIGGER an ALARM immediately. (If the system was PASSIVELY
PROTECTION
ARMED, the ENTRY DELAY must pass after opening a door before the ALARM is
TRIGGERED.)
The RS3200 PLUS utilizes a microphone (usually mounted in the
GLASS BREAKAGE
STATUS MONITOR) to sense the noise from tapping on window glass, or
SENSOR
glass breaking, and TRIGGER the system to sound an ALARM. It is fine
tuned to “listen” for this type of noise, and ignore other sounds.
WARN AWAY ALARM
When the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR’S microphone picks up tapping or
breaking of window glass, it TRIGGERS a WARN AWAY ALARM; the headlights
and tail and marker or turn signal lights flash, and the horn sounds for 20
seconds, but the starter is not disabled. If there is another detection of glass
tapping or breaking, or if a door is opened or unlocked without a key, the
regular ALARM is TRIGGERED.
While ARMED, the RS3200 PLUS monitors the ignition switch. If an attempt is
IGNITION SWITCH
made to start the vehicle without a key, an ALARM is TRIGGERED.
MONITORING
**Starting from 2002 M.Y., Arming Suspension Mode by using the key to unlock the trunk is not applicable
to Camry, Solara, and Corolla.
Page 4
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
BRIEF DESCRIPTION–RS3200 PLUS FEATURES
FEATURES
FUNCTIONS
When an ALARM is TRIGGERED, the system disables the vehicle’s
starter and prevents engine start until the system is reset (DISARMED).
During an ALARM, the system will lock the doors if one is unlocked,
FORCED LOCK
and
will continue to do so for the duration of the ALARM.
DURING ALARM
The user is notified that an ALARM occurred. Upon DISARMING the
TRIGGER MEMORY *
system after an ALARM was TRIGGERED, the vehicle’s tail and marker lights
will be turned on for 2 seconds.
The RS3200 PLUS flashes the vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights
EXTERIOR LIGHT
during REMOTE ARMING and REMOTE DISARMING, and during an ALARM.
ACTIVATION
Also, during an ALARM the headlights flash.
If
your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer that chirps when the lock
BUZZER ACTIVATION
and unlock buttons on the remote keyless entry system’s remote
controls are pressed, the buzzer will also chirp when the system is
REMOTE ARMED and DISARMED.
HORN ACTIVATION
During an ALARM, the RS3200 PLUS activates the vehicle’s horn.
If power to the RS3200 PLUS is disrupted while it is ARMED, an ALARM is
POWER LOSS MEMORY
TRIGGERED once power is restored.
This
panel houses the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR microphone and the
STATUS MONITOR
flashing LED that indicates the operating status of the security system.
(Some vehicle applications utilize the vehicle’s engine immobilizer system
LED and a separate microphone, instead.)
STARTER DISABLE
ALARM INFORMA
ALARM TRIGGERS
While the system is ARMED, an
➤
F
P
a
➤
M
M
N
➤
“
T
t
* TRIGGER MEMORY is not available for Corolla / Matrix.
➤
T
T
A
h
➤
P
I
A
e
em
LL
R 30
S
HEN
THE
RMED
TOYOTA RS3000 PLUS Security system
Page 5
OPERATION
ARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE ARMING)
The system may be ARMED in several ways. Do one of the following:
Lock the doors with your key:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors.*
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary.*
Insert the key into the door key switch and turn it toward the
front of the vehicle:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀ The system is now ARMED.
TURN TOWARD THE
FRONT
OF THE VEHICLE
Lock the doors from inside the vehicle:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Open the driver’s or front passenger’s door.
Push the central lock switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors.*
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary.* Then:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀ The system is now ARMED.
PUSH THE LOCK
SWITCH WHILE THE
and
sing
R’S
Lock the doors with the remote control:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors.*
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary.*
Press the lock button on the remote control. Simultaneously:
The doors lock.➁
The vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights flash
once.③
The vehicle’s buzzer chirps once.∆
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀ The system is now ARMED.
PRESS AND RELEASE
THE LOCK BUTTON
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PREARMING)
THEN
FLASHES
(SYSTEM
IS
ARMED)
➁
ALL DOORS LOCK WHEN
THE SYSTEM IS REMOTE
ARMED
③
THE TAIL AND MARKER OR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHTS FLASH ONCE WHEN THE SYSTEM IS
REMOTE ARMED
* The system will not ARM while any of the doors, trunk or hatch is open.
∆ If your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer.
Page 6
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
OPERATION
OPERATION
DISARMING THE RS3200 PLUS (except PASSIVE DISARMING)
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC)
The system may be DISARMED in several ways. Do one of the following:
When the RS3200 PLUS is prog
is removed and all doors and th
come back to your vehicle and
it to “ON” during the ENTRY DEL
the doors, regular ARMING will o
PROGRAMMING information o
the ENTRY DELAY time. (Not a
Deale
Unlock the doors with your key:
Insert the key into the door key switch and turn it toward the rear of
the vehicle:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED stops flashing.➀The system is
now DISARMED.*
TURN TOWARD THE
REAR
OF THE VEHICLE
In the case of Highlander, Sienna, and 4Runner, you may also disarm
the system using the key in the back door; all doors will unlock at the
same time.
Unlock the doors with the remote control:
Press the unlock button on the remote control. Simultaneously:
The driver’s door unlocks.➁
The vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights flash
twice.➂
The vehicle’s buzzer chirps twice.∆
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED stops flashing.➀The system is
now DISARMED.*
Press the unlock button again within 3 seconds after unlocking the
driver’s door to unlock the remaining doors.
PUSH THE UNLOCK
BUTTON
Use the ignition switch:
Insert the key into the ignition switch, then turn it to ON.
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED stops flashing.➀The system is
now DISARMED.*
TURN THE KEY TO “ON”
TO
DISARM THE SYSTEM
This method of disarming is rarely used. You must be inside the
vehicle while the system is armed in order to do it.
NOTE: If your vehicle’s tail and marker or turn signal lights turn on for 2 seconds when the system
is DISARMED,* the TRIGGER MEMORY was activated; something TRIGGERED an ALARM while
you were away from the vehicle. This feature is not available for Corolla / Matrix.
➀
➁
STOPS
FLASHING
WHEN
THE SYSTEM IS
DISARMED
THE DRIVER’S DOOR
UNLOCKS WHEN THE
SYSTEM IS REMOTE
DISARMED
➂
THE TAIL AND MARKER OR TURN SIGNAL
LIGHTS FLASH TWICE WHEN THE SYSTEM
IS REMOTE DISARMED
* Please note, if the system utilizes your vehicle’s engine immobilizer system LED instead of the
STATUS MONITOR, the LED will continue to flash.
∆ If your vehicle is equipped with a buzzer.
T
R
E
A
C
w
A
THE SYSTEM ARMS 30
SECONDS AFTER THE
LAST ENTRY POINT (DOOR,
TRUNK OR HATCH)
IS CLOSED
T
E
T
I
b
THE SYSTEM DISARMS
WHEN
YOU INSERT THE KEY
AND TURN IT TO “ON”
Y
d
NOTE: If your vehicle’s tail an
is turned to “ON”, the
while you were away f
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PRE-ARMING)
THEN
STARTS
FLASHING
(SYSTEM
IS ARMED)
➁
* If the ENTRY DELAY time elap
TRIGGERED. To DISARM the sy
press and release the remote
of
m is
sarm
the
m is
e
m is
em
e
AL
EM
e
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 7
OPERATION
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC) ARMING & DISARMING
When the RS3200 PLUS is programmed to PASSIVELY ARM, the system will ARM after the ignition key
is removed and all doors and the trunk are closed; you do not need to lock the doors. When you
come back to your vehicle and open a door, you must insert the key into the ignition switch and turn
it to “ON” during the ENTRY DELAY (0, 15 or 30 seconds), or an ALARM will be TRIGGERED. If you lock
the doors, regular ARMING will override PASSIVE ARMING; there will be no ENTRY DELAY. See the
PROGRAMMING information on page 13 to activate the PASSIVE ARMING mode, as well as to select
the ENTRY DELAY time. (Not applicable to Highlander and Sienna. Please consult your Toyota
Dealer for programming information .)
THE SYSTEM ARMS 30
SECONDS AFTER THE
LAST ENTRY POINT (DOOR,
TRUNK OR HATCH)
IS CLOSED
THE SYSTEM DISARMS
WHEN
YOU INSERT THE KEY
AND TURN IT TO “ON”
To PASSIVELY ARM the system:
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Exit the vehicle, and close all the doors. (The system will not
ARM while any of the doors are open.)
Close the trunk or hatch, if necessary. (The system will not ARM
while the trunk or hatch is open.)
After the last door, trunk or hatch is closed:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on for 30 seconds,
then starts flashing.➀The system is now ARMED.
To DISARM the PASSIVELY ARMED system:
Enter the vehicle through a front door.
The ENTRY DELAY begins:
The STATUS MONITOR’S LED turns on (no flashing.)➁
Insert the key into the ignition switch and turn it to “ON”
before the ENTRY DELAY ends.*
The LED turns off. The system is now DISARMED.
You may also DISARM the system following any of the methods
described on page 6.
NOTE: If your vehicle’s tail and marker lights turn on for 2 seconds when the ignition key
is turned to “ON”, the TRIGGER MEMORY was activated; something TRIGGERED an ALARM
while you were away from the vehicle. This feature is not available for Corolla/Matrix.
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PRE-ARMING)
THEN
STARTS
FLASHING
(SYSTEM
IS ARMED)
➁
TURNS
ON (NO
FLASHING)
DURING
THE
ENTRY
DELAY
* If the ENTRY DELAY time elapses before the ignition switch is turned to “ON”, an ALARM will be
TRIGGERED. To DISARM the system during an ALARM, insert the ignition key and turn it to “ON”, or
press and release the remote control’s unlock button.
Page 8
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
OPERATION
OPERATION
AUTOMATIC REARMING
ARMING THE RS3200 P
When you unlock the doors using the remote control, the RS3200 PLUS is DISARMED at the same
time. However, if you do not open a door or the trunk within 30 seconds, the keyless entry system
will relock the doors and the RS3200 PLUS will REARM 30 seconds later.
The system may be ARMED in s
L
R
E
C
I
f
How the RS3200 PLUS automatically REARMS:
0
45
TURN TOWARD THE
FRONT
OF THE VEHICLE
15
30
THE DOORS ARE
UNLOCKED BY
PRESSING THE
UNLOCK BUTTON
ON THE REMOTE
CONTROL...
WHEN NO DOOR,
TRUNK OR HATCH
IS OPENED...
FOR MORE THAN
30
SECONDS...
ARMING SUSPENSION**
THE LED WILL
THE KEYLESS
ENTRY
LIGHT UP FOR 30
SYSTEM AUTOMATSECONDS
(PRE-ARM), THEN
ICALLY RELOCKS
THE DOORS, THEN FLASH WHEN THE
THE RS3200 PLUS SYSTEM IS ARMED
AUTOMATICALLY
REARMS.
L
R
O
P
E
C
PUSH THE LOCK
SWITCH WHILE THE
The ARMED state of the RS3200 PLUS can be suspended temporarily by using the key to unlock and
open the trunk. If your remote control is so equipped, you may also suspend the ARMED state using
the trunk release button➀to open the trunk. When the ARMING is suspended, the STATUS MONITOR’S
LED will turn off ➁until the trunk is closed again.
➀
OPENING THE TRUNK
SUSPENDS THE
ARMED STATE OF THE
SECURITY SYSTEM
L
R
E
C
P
➁
TURNS
OFF
WHEN
THE
ARMED
STATE
IS SUSPENDED
**Starting from 2002 M.Y., Arming
Suspension Mode by using the
key to unlock the trunk is not
applicable to Camry, Solara, and
Corolla.
PRESS AND RELEASE
THE LOCK BUTTON
➀
LIGHTS
FOR 30
SECONDS
(PREARMING)
THEN
FLASHES
(SYSTEM
IS
ARMED)
➁
ALL
THE
* The system will not ARM whil
∆ If your vehicle is equipped w
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 9
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM TRIGGERS
While the system is ARMED, an ALARM will be TRIGGERED when any of the following occurs:
➤
Forcibly opening a door, or the trunk or hatch without a key
Pulling the trunk release lever inside the vehicle will also TRIGGER
an ALARM.
s
ts
m
➤
Manually unlocking a door
Manually operating an inside lock button will TRIGGER an ALARM.
Note: Because this action will TRIGGER an ALARM, it is important
that you do not ARM the system while someone is in the
vehicle.
➤
“Hot wiring” the vehicle
The RS3200 PLUS can detect the absence of the ignition key if
the ignition circuit is shorted in attempt to start the vehicle.
➤
Tapping on or breaking the glass
The noise from tapping on, or breaking of glass TRIGGERS a WARN
AWAY ALARM first, then a regular ALARM. See the description of
how the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR TRIGGERS ALARMS on page 12.
➤
Power restoration
If power to the system is interrupted while it is ARMED, an
ALARM will be TRIGGERED immediately when power is restored.
TOYOTA RS3000 PLUS Security system
Page 10
BRIEF DESCRIP
ALARM INFORMATION
ALARM DESCRIPTIONS
FEATURES
Regular ALARM ➀
When an ALARM is triggered in any way other than initial detection by the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR,
the following occur:
The horn sounds repeatedly for 60 seconds.
The headlights flash repeatedly for 60 seconds.
The tail and marker or turn signal lights flash repeatedly for 60 seconds.
The starter is disabled (no engine start) until the system is DISARMED.
The door lock will be relocked if someone reaches in and unlocks the inside lock button.
After 60 seconds of ALARM, the system will REARM and continue to protect the vehicle.
➀
THE HORN
SOUNDS
FOR 60 SECONDS
THE STARTER IS DISABLED UNTIL THE SYSTEM
IS DISARMED
TAIL OR TURN SIGNAL LIGHTS FLASH
FOR 60 SECONDS
MARKER OR TURN
SIGNAL LIGHTS
FLASH
FOR 60 SECONDS
HEAD LIGHTS
FLASH
FOR 60 SECONDS
WARN-AWAY ALARM ➁
Upon initial detection of noise from tapping on, or breaking glass, the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR
TRIGGERS a WARN AWAY ALARM:
The horn sounds repeatedly for 20 seconds.
The headlights flash repeatedly for 20 seconds.
The tail and marker or turn signal lights flash repeatedly for 20 seconds.
If the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR detects noise again, or if a door or trunk is opened while the system
is still ARMED, the regular ALARM (described above) is activated.
➁
THE HORN
SOUNDS
FOR 20 SECONDS
TAIL OR TURN SIGNAL LIGHTS FLASH
FOR 20 SECONDS
HEADLIGHTS FLASH
FOR 20 SECONDS MARKER OR TURN
SIGNAL LIGHTS FLASH
FOR 20 SECONDS
STOPPING AN ALARM
Simply DISARM the system using the remote control or key as described on page 6.
Th
ke
un
wh
bu
Th
AUTOMATIC
ve
REARMING
do
Th
KEY
op
ARMING/DISARMING
yo
W
ARMED MODE
SUSPENSION**
on
th
Th
PASSIVE (AUTOMATIC)
se
ARMING
la
Th
PASSIVE DISARMING
af
ADJUSTABLE ENTRY
W
DELAY
(u
op
W
MANUAL ARMING
is
th
Th
IGNITION KEY
ig
DISARMING
Fo
POINT-OF-ENTRY
is
PROTECTION
AR
TR
Th
GLASS BREAKAGE
ST
SENSOR
gl
tu
WARN AWAY ALARM
W
br
an
se
ta
re
W
IGNITION SWITCH
m
MONITORING
REMOTE
ARMING/DISARMING
**Starting from 2002 M.Y., Armin
to Camry, Solara, and Corolla
cle!
-
and
na
n
he
ors
em
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 11
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR INFORMATION
The RS3200 PLUS provides protection for your vehicle above and beyond entry point monitoring–it
“listens” for the noise made by tapping on, or breaking of glass. Using a microphone designed
specifically for this task, the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR is capable of ignoring other noises, which
helps to prevent “false alarms” from occurring.
GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR CHECK PROCEDURE
When the RS3200 PLUS was installed in your vehicle, care was taken to adjust the sensitivity level
of the GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR. You may observe how it works following the procedure listed
below.
1.
ARM the system.
Press the lock button on the remote control or lock the doors
with the key.
(Remember, the system will not ARM if any door, the trunk or
hatch is open.)
is
D➂
2.
Wait until the STATUS MONITOR’S LED starts flashing.
The LED will flash 30 seconds after the last door, the trunk or
hatch is closed.
3.
With the tip of a key, tap the center of the driver’s door window.
Tap the glass with light to moderate force.
WARNING: Do not hit the glass with excessive force, especially
in cold weather, or you may crack or break it.
A WARN AWAY ALARM should be TRIGGERED. If the ALARM is not
TRIGGERED, make sure you performed the procedure correctly
and try again. If you find that the system did not perform as
expected, contact your Toyota dealer for more information.
se
4.
DISARM the system to stop the WARN AWAY ALARM.
Press the unlock button on the remote control or use the key
to DISARM the system.
Page 12
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
PROGRAMMING
The RS3200 PLUS is factory-set to not PASSIVELY ARM. To change the system’s operation for
PASSIVE ARMING operation, as well as adjust the ENTRY DELAY time, follow the procedure below. For
more information on this feature, please refer to page 7. (Not applicable to Highlander and
Sienna. Please consult your Toyota Dealer for programming information.)
PASSIVE ARMING ON/OFF SELECTION, ENTRY DELAY TIME SELECTION
1.
Before you begin:
Open the driver’s door. Close the remaining doors
and the trunk or hatch. Unlock all doors with the inside
lock switch. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
2.
Insert and remove the key from
the ignition key cylinder 3
times; this must be completed
within 5 seconds.
Start the Programming Procedure. (Complete these steps within 40 seconds.)
To better understand the featu
Guide completely prior to use.
TABLE OF CONT
INTRODUCTION
BRIEF DESCRIPTIO
OPERATION
ARMING THE RS
DISARMING THE
PASSIVE (AUTOM
AUTOMATIC REA
ARMING SUSPEN
ALARM INFORMATIO
a. Close the driver’s
door.
b. Lock and unlock all
doors 3 times by key
or remote control.
c.
Open and close
the driver’s door.
d. Lock, then unlock
the driver’s door
inside lock button
3 times.
ALARM TRIGGER
ALARM DESCRIP
STOPPING AN AL
GLASS BREAKAGE
GLASS BREAKAG
PROGRAMMING
PASSIVE (AUTOM
(Not applicable to
Toyota Dealer for
e. Open the driver’s
door.
3.
f.
The system locks the door
in 2 seconds; if this does
not happen, start over.
g. Unlock the driver’s
door knob.
Select the Operating Mode and Complete the Programming Procedure.
a. Close, then Open the driver’s door: b. Lock then unlock the
2 times = PASSIVE ARMING OFF
driver’s door inside lock
3 times = PASSIVE ARMING ON,
button 1 time.
0 Sec. ENTRY DELAY
4 times = PASSIVE ARMING ON,
15 Sec. ENTRY DELAY
5 times = PASSIVE ARMING ON,
30 Sec. ENTRY DELAY
c.
The system locks the
door in 2 seconds; if this
does not happen, start
over. Programming is now
complete.
WARNING and CAUT
TOYOTA RS3200 PLUS Security system
Page 13
Warning
•
This product is applicable only to vehicles with 12V DC, negative grounding specifications. Do
not use in vehicles with 24V specifications. Otherwise, damage to the unit or a fire may result.
•
Never attempt to disassemble or modify the product. Otherwise, an accident, fire or electric
shock may result.
•
When replacing fuses, be sure to use fuses with the same specified capacity (amperage.)
Otherwise, damage to the unit or vehicle, fire or electric shock may result.
•
If an abnormal condition occurs, such as liquids spilling onto the product, or the product
emitting smoke or strange odors, stop using it immediately and consult the dealer from whom
you purchased the product. Continued use of the product before corrective actions are taken
may result in an accident, injury or fire.
•
Never pull the plastic bag over your head. Otherwise, a serious injury or death from suffocation
may occur.
Caution
•
Do not use this product for applications other than in-vehicle use. Otherwise, an electric shock
or injury may result.
•
Do not allow children to play with the remote controls. Otherwise, the doors may be locked or
unlocked, the security system armed or disarmed, or an alarm triggered unintentionally.
•
If this product is dropped or its case is damaged, disconnect the power supply lead and
contact the dealer from whom you purchased it to obtain service. Otherwise, a fire or electric
shock may result.
RS3
SECURI
DESIGN
REMOT
OWN
090002-25520700
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Part Number: Mounting Kit PT546-89060
Tuner Assy 86180-0W030
Tuner Assy Kit Contents (86180-0W030)
Item #
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
Description
TUNER ASSY,
STEREO COMPONENT
Quantity Reqd.
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
1
Description
Antenna
Bracket Ass’y SDARS
Receiver
Wire, To Radio Installation
Base Bracket Ass’y SDARS
Receiver
Ground Cord
Hardware Bag Contents 1 (PT546-89060)
Item #
1
2
3
4
Quantity Reqd.
2
6
1
1
Description
Cushion Tape (100mm×50mm)
Lock Tie A
Template
Butyl cushions
Quantity Reqd.
4
4
Quantity Reqd.
1
1
7
1
4
1
1
1
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Housing
Template
Nylon Tape (30mm×30mm)
Lock Tie B
Cable Rail (150mm)
Cable Rail (20mm)
Cable Rail (10mm)
Cushion Tape (40mm ×80mm)
Description
Conflicts
Vehicles with third row seat
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
Wrench
Socket
Phillips Screwdriver
Nylon Removal Tool
Torque Wrench
Open End, 10mm
10mm, 12mm, 14mm
Utility Knife
Masking Tape
Special Chemicals
Cleaner
03/02/06
Notes
3MTM Prepsolvent-70
General Applicability
Accessory
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Item #
1
2
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Legend
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
Notes
Safety Goggles
Issue: A
4.1 N-m (3 lbf·ft), 42 N-m
(31 lbf·ft), 37 N-m (27 lbf·ft)
*Mandatory
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
Installation Tools
Item #
1
2
Description
Screw (M5×L8 )
Nut (M6)
Hardware Bag Contents 3 (PT546-89060)
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Notes
Recommended Sequence of Application
Hardware Bag Contents 2 (PT546-89060)
Item #
1
2
Special Tools
None
Mounting Kit Contents (PT546-89060)
Item #
1
2
Seat Covers
Floor Protectors
Page 1 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Preparation
Parts Description of Tuner Assy (86180-0W030)
Item #
Parts Name
Tuner
1
Parts No.
Qty
86180-0W030
1
Parts Description of Mounting Kit (PT546-89060)
Item #
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
A
B
C
D
E
11
F
G
H
I
Issue: A
Parts Name
Wire, To Radio Installation
Cushion Tape (100mm x 50mm)
Lock Tie A
Ground cord
Template
Bracket Ass’y SDARS Receiver
Base Bracket Ass’y SDARS Receiver
Screw (M5 x L8)
Nut (M6)
Butyl Cushions
Antenna
Housing
Template
Nylon Tape (30mm x30mm)
Lock Tie B
Cable Rail (L=150mm)
Cable Rail (L=20mm)
Cable Rail (L=10mm)
Cushion Tape (80mm x 40mm)
03/02/06
Parts No.
Qty
1
2
6
1
1
2
2
4
4
1
1
1
1
7
1
4
1
1
1
Page 2 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
1. Remove the Negative (–) Battery Cable.
(Fig. 1-1):
Negative battery cable
(a) Protect the fender before removing the
battery cable.
(b) Be careful not to touch the positive terminal.
10 mm Socket
Fig. 1-1
2. Disassembly of Rear Cargo Area.
(a) Remove the trunk mat. (Fig. 2-1)
(b) Remove the rear scuff trim. (Fig. 2-2)
(c) Remove the rear deck board (Fig 2-2)
Fig. 2-1
Rear deck board
Rear scuff trim
Fig. 2-2
Issue: A
03/02/06
Bolts x 2
Screw x5
Phillips screwdriver
12mm socket
Page 3 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(d) Rear right seat (Fig. 2-3)
(1) Remove rear right seat back headrests.
(2) Fold seat bench forward by lifting rear of
seat forward.
(3) Pull the rear seatback release button and
tilt the rear right seat back forward.
Fig. 2-3
(e) Remove RR Seat Belt Anchor and Trim
Cover. (Fig 2-4)
14mm socket
Nylon Pry Tool
NOTE: Use protective cloth and tape to cover
seat belt anchor after removal.
Bolt x 1
Trim Cover
Fig. 2-4
(f) Remove rear right door scuff plate. (Fig 2-5)
(g) Remove the right rear trim panel. (Fig. 2-6)
Clips x 7
(1) Remove 2 bolts as shown. Fold back
right rear cargo area carpet and remove 3
screws securing quarter panel trim.
(2) Using Nylon Pry Tool remove the plastic
plugs as shown.
Nylon Pry Tool
Fig. 2-5
(3) Disconnect the auxiliary power jack.
10mm Socket
Phillips Screwdriver
Nylon Pry Tool
Bolts x 2
Plastic Plug
Fig. 2-6
Issue: A
Screws x 3
03/02/06
Auxiliary power jack
Page 4 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(h) Remove the taillight
10mm Open ended wrench
(1) From the inside corner, remove the tail
lamp nuts, disconnect the harness
connector, then remove the tail lamp
assembly. (Fig. 2-7)
Nut x2
(i) Remove front seat belt anchor and B-pillar
trim panel. Fig. (2-8)
Fig. 2-7
3. Disassemble Vehicle Interior
(a) Remove the front right scuff plate and cowl
side trim.
Clips x 6
(1) Remove the right scuff plate, and then
remove the cowl side trim (R).
(Fig 3-1)
Fig. 2-8
Bolt x 1
(2) Remove the scuff plate in order from
front (c) to rear (d) using a nylon pry
tool.
14 mm Socket
Nylon Pry Tool
Molded Pins (x6)
Nylon Pry Tool
Molded Pins (x2)
(3) Remove the cowl side trim, secured by
one (1) clip and two (2) molded pins.
(b) Remove front seat belt anchor and B-pillar
trim panel. Fig. (3-2)
Fig. 3-1
Clips x 6
Fig. 3-2
Issue: A
Bolt x 1
03/02/06
14 mm Socket
Nylon Pry Tool
Page 5 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(c) Remove the glove compartment door.
(1) Release the glove compartment stoppers
by pressing both glove box side panels
inward. (Fig. 3-3)
Phillips #2
Stubby Screwdriver
(2) Remove the damper, using a Phillips #2
stubby screwdriver.
(3) Remove the glove box from the hinge
hooks on the rear.
Fig. 3-3
(d) Remove the upper glove box.
(1) Remove the screws, then pull the upper
glove box trim outward to access the SRS
harness connector. (Fig. 3-4
Screws x4
(2) Push the SRS harness bracket clips
inward to release the bracket from the
glove box trim. (Fig. 3-5)
(3) Disengage the SRS harness connector
bracket, and then remove the upper glove
box.
Fig. 3-4
SRS Harness Bracket Clips
(e) Remove Shift Cover, Side Covers and Coin
Box. (Fig. 3-6)
(1) Protect center cluster with the tape to
avoid the damage to center cluster when
removing console box.
Fig. 3-5
(2) Remove the shift cover in order from c
to h using a nylon pry tool.
(3) Use the nylon pry tool to disengage the
clip under the left side cover (L).
(4) Use the nylon pry tool to disengage clip
under the right side cover (R).
Nylon Pry Tool
Fig. 3-6
Issue: A
03/02/06
(5) Unplug the connector.
Page 6 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(f) Remove the Center Console Cover.
(1) Use nylon pry tool to disengage six clips
on rear cover as shown. (Fig. 3-7)
(g) Remove driver’s side underdash trim panel.
(Fig. 3-8).
Fig. 3-7
(1) The dash panel must be removed to
access the center console bolt.
Nylon Pry Tool
(2) Remove 2 bolts as shown.
(3) Disengage 4 claws using Nylon Pry Tool.
(h) Remove the air conditioner unit. (Fig. 3-9)
Bolts x 2
Claws x 4
(1) Remove the screw on air conditioner unit
with a Phillips screwdriver.
(2) Remove plug from cluster.
Nylon Pry Tool
10 mm Socket
Fig. 3-8
(3) Remove two (2) plugs from the center
cluster.
(i) Remove the Audio Unit (Fig. 3-9)
(1) Using a 10 mm socket, remove two bolts
on the audio unit.
(2) Remove the connectors from the rear of
the unit.
Phillips Screwdriver
10 mm Socket
Fig. 3-9
14 mm Socket
(j) Remove the Front Passenger Seat.
(1) Remove the covers and bolts (x4) from
the front passenger seat mounting
bracket, then tilt the seat backwards.
(Fig.s 3-10 and 3-11)
NOTE: Do not disconnect the harness from the seat
or remove the seat from the vehicle.
Seat bolts
and covers x4
Fig. 3-10
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 7 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
Rear side seat bolt
and cover
Front side seat bolt
and cover
Fig. 3-11
4. Antenna Installation
Template
Tailgate
Fig. 4-1
Center of Roof
(a) Using 3MTM Prepsolvent-70, carefully clean
the mounting surface for the template,
antenna, tape, and cable rails.
(b) Tape the antenna mounting template onto the
rear roof section. (Fig. 4-1)
TAPE
(1) Remove the backing from the antenna,
and then install the antenna onto the roof
along the template guide lines. Remove
and discard the template.
10mm Cable Rail
Rear door
Antenna wire
(c) Route the antenna wire as follows.
Tape
Cable rails x2 - 150mm
(1) Route the antenna wire into and along the
rear door channel toward the RR tail
lamp to route the antenna wire as shown.
(Fig. 4-2, Fig. 4-3)
Fig. 4-2
20mm Cable rail
Cable rails x2
150mm
Fig. 4-3
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 8 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(d) Insert the antenna wire through the access
hole in the tail lamp mounting base and into
the vehicle interior. (Fig. 4-4)
RR tail lamp
mounting base
Access hole
between body
walls
NOTE: Do not take off Anti-Static Bag
until antenna terminal is plugged into
Satellite Receiver.
Anti-Static Bag
Fig. 4-4
(1) Slide grommet to remove any slack.
(2) Plug the access hole with the rubber
grommet supplied with the antenna wire.
(3) Tape the antenna wire in the tail lamp
area as shown. (Fig. 4-5)
Tape x5
NOTE: Using 3MTM Prepsolvent-70, carefully
clean any tape mounting surface.
Fig.4-5
(e) Cut the supplied foam cushion tape in half.
Cushion tape
(g) Route the antenna wire along the right rear
body panel with the windshield washer hose
and using existing wire clips. Apply ½ foam
cushion tape to the body panel at location
shown. (Fig 4-7)
Antenna Wire
Fig. 4-6
½ foam cushion tape
Fig. 4-7
Issue: A
(f) Remove excess antenna slack, then secure to
the body panel with ½ cushion tape as
shown. (Fig. 4-6)
03/02/06
Page 9 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
If equipped with optional subwoofer.
NOTE: Apply ½ foam cushion tape to the
existing wire harness if equipped with
subwoofer assy. (Fig 4-8)
(h) Route the antenna wire with the rear window
washer hose along the RR door sill. Stop at
the B-pillar. (Fig.s 4-9, 4-10)
½ foam cushion tape
Fig. 4-8
(i) Route antenna wire along existing wire
harness along wheel well. Lock tie to
existing harness. (Fig 4-9)
Washer hose
RH rear door
opening
Lock tie
Antenna wire
Fig. 4-9
Existing harness clamps
(j) Secure antenna wire under the existing
harness clamps on the RR rear door sill.
(Fig. 4-10)
5. Install the Tuner Harness and Ground Wire.
Secure antenna cable here
(a) Install the Tuner Harness
Fig. 4-10
Radio harness
Tuner
harness
Lock tie x2
(1) Starting from the cowl side area, route
the tuner harness upwards into the glove
box area above the reinforcement bar,
then into the center opening.
(Fig 5-1, 5-2, and 5-3)
Ground
wire
Fig. 5-1
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 10 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(b) Install the Ground Wire.
10 mm Socket
(1) Route the ground wire into the cowl side
trim area, then attach the ground terminal
onto the existing ground screw as shown
(Fig 5-2)
Lock tie
(c) Install lock ties.
Ground
connection
Fig. 5-2
(1) Install 1 Lock Tie to secure the tuner
harness to the existing harness.
(Fig. 5-2)
(2) Install 2 Lock Ties to secure the tuner
harness to the existing harness.
(Fig. 5-3)
Lock tie x2
(3) Install 1 Lock Tie to secure the tuner
harness to the existing harness.
(Fig. 5-4)
Fig. 5-3
6. Install the Tuner and Harness
(a) Cut the carpet opening at the location shown
to allow the seat harness to be moved without
damaging connectors to the seat. (Fig. 6-1)
Lock tie
NOTE: Be careful not to cut seat harness
Fig. 5-4
120 mm
Cut Floor Carpet
Utility Knife
Fig. 6-1
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 11 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
(b) Align the template on the carpet. Using the
existing cut along the side of the heater duct
place the left mounting bracket at this
location. Using the bracket as a template,
transfer the hole locations to the carpet then
cut two 7 mm holes onto the carpet.
(Fig. 6-2)
Cut Two 7 mm Holes
Utility Knife
Fig. 6-2
Tuner base
bracket, LH
(c) Add butyl cushions spacers (adhesive pads)
to the tuner base brackets. (Fig. 6-3)
Add corner pad
Adhesive pad x4
Tuner base
bracket, RH
FWD
Fig. 6-3
Tuner unit
Phillips Screwdriver
(d) Assemble the side brackets onto the tuner.
(Fig. 6-4)
Side bracket x2
Hex screws x4
Fig. 6-4
Cushion tape
(100 x 50mm)
(e) Route the antenna wire from the B-Pillar area
toward the tuner mounting area, then tape the
antenna wire in place as shown. (Fig. 6-5)
(f) Route the tuner harness and ground wire
along the rear right door scuff plate channel
then toward the tuner mounting area.
B-pillar
Antenna wire
Fig. 6-5
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 12 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
Antenna Wire
Existing seat harness
Ground Wire
(g) Route harness and wires to the tuner mount
area. (Fig. 6-6)
(1) Relocate the existing seat harness into the
new opening shown.
NOTE: Route the tuner harness, antenna wire
and ground wire through carpet openings.
Fig. 6-6
1 - Remove to insert
terminal.
(h) Take off Anti-Static bag and insert the
antenna terminal into the connector housing.
(Fig. 6-7)
Connector
housing
2 - Replace to lock.
3 - Insert antenna
terminal into connector
Antenna wire
Fig. 6-7
(i) Install the tuner unit. (Fig. 6-8)
NOTE: Trial fit the tuner before mounting in
place.
Cushion Tape
Nuts x 4
(1) Using 3MTM Prepsolvent-70, carefully
clean the mounting surface.
(2) Remove the adhesive backing from each
tuner base bracket, then install onto the
floor of the vehicle with the studs
sticking up through the carpet openings.
Fig. 6-8
(3) Install the tuner onto the base brackets as
shown using the M6 nuts. (Fig. 6-8)
(4) Install the ground wire terminal under
one of the side bracket screws.
(5) Plug the tuner cable and antenna cable
into the tuner unit.
(6) Tape the existing seat harness to the top
of the tuner. (Fig. 6-8)
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 13 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Procedure
7. Re-install the Radio Unit
Tuner
harness
(a) Plug the tuner connector into the radio unit,
and then reinstall the radio. (Fig. 7-1)
(b) If the vehicle is equipped with other options,
such as any radio controlled unit, use and
connect the other harness connectors from
the additional modules to the radio unit.
Radio unit
Fig. 7-1
8. Reconnect the Negative Battery Cable.
Negative battery cable
(a) Reconnected the vehicle’s negative battery
cable at original factory position. (Fig. 8-1)
(1) Tighten the nut to 36 lbf in. (4.1 N-m)
(2) Do not touch the positive terminal with
any tool when replacing the cable.
9. Proceed to Checklist (page 15)
10 mm Socket,
Torque Wrench
Fig. 8-1
(a) Complete checklist before reassembly of
vehicle.
10. Reassembly
(1) Reassemble the removed panels and
connectors.
(2) Reinstall the front seat bolts. Specified
tightening torque: 37 N-m (375 kgf-cm)
(27 lbf-ft)
(3) Reinstall seat belt anchor bolts:
Specified tightening torque: 42 N-m (430
kgf-cm) (31 lbf-ft)
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 14 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
4RUNNER
2006 -
xM SATELLITE RADIO
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Verify the proper operation of the satellite
radio tuner. Refer to the tuner assembly and
radio owner’s manuals.
Verify the proper operation of the tuner
assembly and radio. Refer to the tuner
assembly and radio owner’s manuals.
Vehicle Function Checks
Verify the proper operation of the hazard
switch.
Verify the removed seat is securely
fastened.
Verify the proper operation of the removed
seat lock mechanism.
Verify the proper operation of the air
conditioning system.
Verify the proper operation of the multiinformation displays.
Verify the proper operation of the R/R
taillight assembly.
Verify the proper operation of the rear 12V
auxiliary power jack.
Verify the proper operation of the 4WD
switch.
Verify the proper operation of the Rear
window switch.
Verify the proper operation of the
differential lock switch.
Verify the proper operation of the seat
heaters.
Issue: A
03/02/06
Page 15 of 15 pages
TOYOTA
ALL VEHICLES
ALL YEARS
FIRST AID KIT
Preparation
NOTE: Part number of this accessory may not be
the same as the part number shown.
Vehicle Service Parts (may be required for reassembly)
Part Number: PT420-03023
Kit Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
1
Item #
1
2
3
Description
First Aid Kit
Hardware Bag Contents
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Legend
Description
Additional Items Required For Installation
Item #
1
2
3
Quantity Reqd.
Description
Conflicts
STOP: Damage to the vehicle may occur. Do not
proceed until process has been complied with.
OPERATOR SAFETY: Use caution to avoid risk of
injury.
CAUTION: A process that must be carefully observed
in order to reduce the risk of damage to the
accessory/vehicle and to ensure a quality installation.
TOOLS & EQUIPMENT: Used in Figures calls out the
specific tools and equipment recommended for this
process.
REVISION MARK: This mark highlights a change in
installation with respect to previous issue.
Note: None
Recommended Tools
Personal & Vehicle
Protection
Notes
None
Special Tools
Notes
None
Installation Tools
Notes
None
Special Chemicals
Notes
None
General Applicability
Note: All Toyota Vehicles
Recommended Sequence of Application
Item #
1
2
3
Accessory
*Mandatory
Issue: G
09/26/06
Page 1 of 3 pages
PPO
TOYOTA
ALL VEHICLES
ALL YEARS
FIRST AID KIT
Procedure
Care must be taken when installing this accessory to ensure damage does not occur to the vehicle. The installation of this
accessory should follow approved guidelines to ensure a quality installation.
These guidelines can be found in the "Accessory Installation Practices" document.
This document covers such items as:• Vehicle Protection (use of covers and blankets, cleaning chemicals, etc.).
• Safety (eye protection, rechecking torque procedure, etc.).
• Vehicle Disassembly/Reassembly (panel removal, part storage, etc.).
• Electrical Component Disassembly/Reassembly (battery disconnection, connector removal, etc.).
Please see your Toyota dealer for a copy of this document.
NOTES: “FAK” denotes First Aid Kit
1. Install First Aid Kit.
(A) Cars / SUVs / VAN: Place the FAK in the
right rear corner of the trunk / cargo area of
the vehicle. (Do not remove FAK from
package). (Fig 1-1)
Fig. 1-1
(B) Trucks: Place the FAK on the right / front
floor of the vehicle. (Do not remove FAK
from package). (Fig 1-2)
Fig. 1-2
Issue: G
09/26/06
Page 2 of 3 pages
PPO
TOYOTA
ALL VEHICLES
ALL YEARS
FIRST AID KIT
Checklist - these points MUST be checked to ensure a quality installation.
Check:
Look For:
Accessory Function Checks
Confirm proper placement of First Aid Kit.
Whenever possible, “Toyota” name is
visible and upright.
Vehicle Function Checks
Issue: G
09/26/06
Page 3 of 3 pages
PPO
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 1
TOYOTA and SCION
XM Satellite Radio Tuner
86180-0W030
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Rev. A 12/12/2006
PAGE - 2
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
DESCRIPTION
PAGE
Failure Analysis by the DTC (DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
CODE) for the Navigation system
3 - 8, 17, 18
Failure Analysis by the DTC for the Audio system
9 – 18
Satellite Radio Tuner Power Source Circuit
19
Satellite Radio Broadcast cannot be Received
20 - 23
Cannot Change from FM / AM to Satellite Radio
24 -25
Satellite Radio Broadcast cannot be selected
or After Selecting Broadcast, Broadcast cannot
be added into Memory
26 - 28
Satellite Radio cannot Receive Pay Type Broadcasts
29 - 30
Warning
This troubleshooting guide is in addition to the Audio or Navigation
System Troubleshooting Guide for the XM Satellite Radio Tuner
(86180-0W030) of each vehicle.
Therefore, if you analyze the XM satellite radio tuner failure mode,
you have to refer not only this guide but also the vehicle audio or
navigation system troubleshooting guide and the XM radio tuner
installation manual at the same time.
*In some multimedia and navigation systems, if you disconnect
the negative (-) battery terminal, you may have to initialize the multi
media systems after the cable is reconnected.
You may also have to refer the vehicle audio or navigation system
troubleshooting guide about these procedures.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 3
Failure Analysis by the DTC (DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE)
for the Navigation system
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
HINT:
• Illustrations may differ from the actual
vehicle depending on the device settings
and options. Therefore, some detailed
areas may not be exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
• If the system cannot enter the diagnostic
mode, inspect all AVC-LAN
communication components and repair
or replace problem parts (see VEHICLE
AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE).
•
After the engine switch is turned on (IG),
check that the map is displayed before
starting the diagnostic mode.
Otherwise, some items cannot
be checked.
1. START DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Turn the engine switch on (ACC).
(b) Press the "DISP" switch.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 4
(b) From the display quality adjustment
screen, touch the corners of the
screen in the following order:
upper left →lower left
→upper left →lower left
→upper left →lower left.
(c) The diagnostic mode starts and
the "System Check Mode" screen
will be displayed. Service inspection
starts automatically and the result
will be displayed.
2. FINISH DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Turn the engine switch off.
3. DIAGNOSIS MENU
(a) Press the menu button on the “System
Check Mode” screen to enter the "Diagnosis
MENU“.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 5
4. CHECK DTC
(a) Read the system check result.
(1) If the check result is "EXCH", "CHEK“
or "Old", touch the displayed check
result to view the results on the "Unit
Check Mode" screen and record them.
HINT:
If all check results are "OK", go to
the communication DTC check.
If a device name is not known,
its physical address is displayed.
HINT:
When proceeding to view the results
of another device, press the service
switch to return to the "System Check
Mode" screen.
Repeat this step.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 6
(b) Read the communication diagnostic
check result.
(1) Return to the "System Check Mode“
screen, and press the "LAN Mon“
switch to enter the "LAN Monitor“
screen.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 7
(2) If the check result is "CHEK" or "OLd",
touch the displayed check result to
view the results on the individual
communication diagnostic screen and
record them.
HINT:
If all check results are "No Err",
the system judges that no DTC
exists.
The sub-code (relevant device)
will be indicated by its physical
address.
When proceeding to view the
results of another device, press
the "Service" switch to return to
the original "LAN Monitor" screen.
Repeat this step.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 8
5. DTC CLEAR/RECHECK
(a) Clear DTC
(1) Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3
seconds.
(2) The check results are cleared.
(b) Recheck
(1) Press the "Recheck" switch.
(2) Confirm that all diagnostic codes
are "OK" when the check results
are displayed. If a code other than
"OK" is displayed, troubleshoot
again.
(3) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to
change to the "LAN Monitor“
screen.
(4) Confirm that all diagnostic codes
are "No Err". If a code other than
"No Err" is displayed, troubleshoot
again.
NEXT
GO TO DESCRIPTION TABLE
(See Page 17)
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 9
Failure Analysis by the DTC (DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE)
for the Audio system
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
HINT:
• Illustrations may differ from the actual
vehicle depending on the device settings
and options. Therefore, some detailed
areas may not be exactly the same as on
the actual vehicle.
• If the system cannot enter the diagnostic
mode, inspect all AVC-LAN
communication components and repair
or replace problem parts (see VEHICLE
AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE).
1. START DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Turn the engine switch on (ACC).
(b) Turn off the audio system.
(c) While pressing the preset switches "1" and
"6" at the same time, press the "DISC"
switch 3 times.
HINT:
A beep is emitted 3 times and the diagnostic
function is activated. The system enters
the all element illumination mode and
the switch check mode.
2. SERVICE CHECK MODE
(a) Press the "SEEK TRACK UP" switch.
HINT:
For details of the service check mode, refer to
“4.CHECK DTC" and
“5. DTC CLEAR/RECHECK".
3. FINISHING DIAGNOSTIC MODE
•
Press the "DISC" switch for 2 seconds
or more, or turn the engine switch off.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 10
4. CHECK DTC
HINT:
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle
depending on the device settings and options.
Therefore, some detailed areas may not be
shown exactly the same as on the actual
vehicle.
(a) Reference:
In the system check mode, the system check
and the diagnostic memory check are
performed, and the check results are
displayed in ascending order of the
component codes (physical address).
(b) Service check result display
(c) Device name and physical address
Physical Address #
Equipment
190
Audio (Radio receiver)
440
Stereo component Amplifier
19D(*1)
1F1
"Bluetooth" Hands Free Module
XM Satellite Radio Tuner
*1: for Radio Receiver with Built-in "Bluetooth" Hands free Function
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 11
(d) Service check mode
(1) Press the "SEEK TRACK" switch to see
the check result of each component.
(2) The component code (physical address)
is displayed first, and then the check
result follows.
HINT:
• If all check results are “good”,
the system judges that no DTC exists.
• If the preset switch "1" is pressed in the
service check mode, service check is
performed again.
• This illustration is only an example and
may differ in cases such as for each
option part and output DTCs.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 12
(e) Detailed information mode 1
HINT:
• “Detailed information mode 1” is displayed when there
is no response to “System Check
Result Request" and DTC is detected only in
"Diagnostic Memory Request".
• The component device code (physical address) is
displayed first, and then the check result follows.
• This illustration is only an example and may differ in
cases such as for each option part and output
DTCs.
(1) Press the preset switch “2” to go to the “Detailed
Information Mode 1".
(2) Press the "SEEK TRACK" switch to display the physical
address and DTC of the component.
(3) Press the preset switch “3” to go to the “Service Check
Mode".
(4) Distinguish between the displays of the responses to
"System Check Result Request“ and "Diagnostic Memory
Request".
In order to distinguish the information detected
in "System Check Mode" and "Diagnostic
Memory code" in "ECHn", "CHEC", and "OLd" in
"Detailed Information Mode 1", refer to the following:
• "SyS" is displayed before the detailed codes detected
as a result of "System Check Result Request"
are displayed.
• "COdE" is displayed before the detailed codes detected
as a result of "Diagnostic Memory Request" are
displayed.
HINT:
• The response to "System Check Result Request" is the
current information given from each ECU as a result of
the system check.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory Request" contains
the information received from each ECU or stored in
each ECU in the past.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 13
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory
Request" is the output DTCs as a result
of the diagnostic memory check or
the DTCs received from each ECU.
• "System Check Result Request (SyS)“
is displayed first, and then the logical
address and DTC appear in order.
• "Diagnostic Memory Request (COdE)" is
displayed first, and then the logical
address, DTC, sub-code, connection
check number, and the number of
occurrence appear in order.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 14
(f) Detailed information mode 2
HINT:
• "Detailed information mode 2" is displayed when DTCs are
detected in the responses to both "System Check Result
Request" and "Diagnostic Memory Request".
• The component device code (physical address) is
displayed first, and then the check result follows.
• This illustration is only an example and may differ in cases such
as for each option part and output DTCs.
(1) Press the preset switch "2" to go to the "Detailed
Information Mode 2".
(2) Press the "SEEK TRACK" switch to display the physical
address and DTC of the component.
(3) Press the preset switch "3" to go to the "Service Check
Mode".
(4) Distinguish between the displays of the responses
to "System Check Result Request“ and "Diagnostic
Memory Request". In order to distinguish the information
detected in "System Check Mode“ and "Diagnostic
Memory Mode" in "ECHn", "CHEC", and "OLd" in "Detailed
Information Mode 2", refer to the following:
• "SyS" is displayed before the detailed codes detected
as a result of "System Check Result Request" are
displayed.
• "COdE" is displayed before the detailed codes detected
as a result of "Diagnostic Memory Request" are displayed.
HINT:
• The response to "System Check Result Request" is the
current information given from each ECU as a result of the
system check.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory Request“ contains
the information received from each ECU or stored in each
ECU in the past.
• The response to "Diagnostic Memory Request" is the output
DTCs as a result of the diagnostic memory check or the DTCs
received from each ECU.
• "System Check Result Request (SyS)“ is displayed first,
and then the logical address and DTC appear in order.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 15
• "Diagnostic Memory Request (COdE)“ is displayed
first, and then the logical address, DTC, sub-code,
connection check number, and the number of
occurrence appear in order.
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 16
5. DTC CLEAR/RECHECK
(a) Clearing All DTC Memory (when clearing all
the memory of the DTCs previously detected).
(1) When the preset switch "5" is pressed for 2
seconds or more during "Service Check
Mode", the DTCs for all components are
cleared. ("CLr“ is displayed at this time.)
HINT:
• A beep sound is emitted once when the DTC
memory is completely cleared.
• When the DTC memory for all the components
is cleared, only the component codes (physical
address) are displayed.
• After the DTC memory is cleared, the "Service
Check Mode" is restored.
(b) Clearing Individual DTC Memory (when
clearing the memory of the DTC previously
detected individually).
(1) When the preset switch "5" is pressed for
2 seconds or more during "Detailed
Information Mode 1" or "Detailed Information
Mode 2", the DTCs for the target component
are cleared.
HINT:
• A beep sound is emitted once when the DTC
memory is completely cleared.
• When the DTC memory is cleared, only
the component code (physical address) is
displayed for the target component.
• After the DTC memory is cleared, the "Service
Check Mode" is restored.
• To check DTCs, press the preset switch "1“
and perform the system check again.
(c) Press the preset switch "1" to perform the service
check again, and check that no DTCs are displayed
for all the component codes (physical address).
NEXT
GO TO DESCRIPTION TABLE
(See Page 17)
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
DTC
C0-11
Satellite Radio Tuner Internal Circuit Error 1
DTC
C0-12
Satellite Radio Tuner Internal Circuit Error 2
DTC
C0-13
Satellite Radio Tuner Internal Circuit Error 3
DTC
C0-14
Satellite Radio Tuner Internal Circuit Error 4
DTC
C0-15
Satellite Radio Tuner Internal Circuit Error 5
DTC
C0-16
Satellite Radio Tuner Internal Circuit Error 6
PAGE - 17
CAUTION: Audio system will display “ _ ” instead of “ - ” on the DTC #.
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C0-11
Satellite radio tuner malfunction
Satellite radio tuner
C0-12
C0-13
C0-14
C0-15
C0-16
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK SURROUNDINGS
• Check if the vehicle is in an environment
where reception is difficult due to something
blocking the area above the vehicle.
HINT:
If the area above the vehicle is blocked,
such as when in a building or tunnel,
reception may not be possible.
OK:
Area above vehicle is not blocked
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
NG
PAGE - 18
END
(MOVE THE VEHICLE TO LOCATION
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PAGE - 19
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Satellite Radio Tuner Power Source Circuit
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE
• Remove the ACC and +B FUSE from
the junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the FUSE.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ACC
Always
Below 1 Ohm
+B
Always
Below 1 Ohm
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(SATELLITE RADIO TUNER - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the left picture’s tuner
connector.
•Measure the resistance according
to the value(s) in the below table.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Terminal #7 - Body GND
Always
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ohm
(c) Measure the voltage according to
the value(s) in the below table.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
OK
Condition
Specified Condition
Terminal #12(+B) - Terminal #7(GND)
Always
11 to 14V
Terminal #11(ACC) - Terminal #7(GND)
Always
11 to 14V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE, HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN
IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 20
Satellite Radio Broadcast cannot be Received
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Some satellite radio broadcast require payment. A contract must be made
between a satellite radio company and the user. If the contract expires, the
broadcast will not be able to be listened to or viewed.
1
CHECK AUDIO SYSTEM
• Check if noise occurs when using
other sources (CD,DVD, AM, FM, etc.).
OK:
Other sources are normal
NG
GO TO VEHICLE AUDIO AND VISUAL
SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
OK
2
CHECK SURROUNDINGS
• Check if the vehicle is in an environment
where reception is difficult due to something
blocking the area above the vehicle.
HINT:
If the area above the vehicle is blocked,
such as when in a building or tunnel,
reception may not be possible.
OK:
Area above vehicle is not blocked
NG
OK
3
CHECK DISPLAY
END
(MOVE THE VEHICLE TO LOCATION
PAGE - 21
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
3
CHECK DISPLAY
(a)
Check the display's screen.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
"OFF AIR" is displayed
A
"ANTENNA" is displayed
B
"LOADING" is displayed
C
"NO SIGNAL" is displayed
D
None of the displays above are shown
E
A
CHANNEL IS CURRENTLY NOT BEING
BROADCAST.
IF BROADCAST RESUMES, MEMORY
FUNCTION CAN BE PERFORMED
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 7
D
REPLACE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
ASSEMBLY (See Installation Manual)
E
4
CONFIRM CURRENTLY SELECTED CHANNEL
(a) Confirm if CH000 is currently selected.
OK:
CH000 is selected
OK
END (CH000 HAS NO SOUND. SELECT
ANOTHER CHANNEL.)
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN
IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PAGE - 22
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
5
CHECK DTC
(a) Check for DTCs.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
"C0-40" is output
A
"C0-41" is output
B
CAUTION: Audio system will display “ _ ”
instead of “ - ” as the DTC #.
B
REPLACE ANTENNA OR ANTENNA
CABLE (See Installation Manual)
A
6
CHECK CONNECTION OF ANTENNA CABLE
(a) Check if the antenna cable is securely connected to
the satellite radio tuner and antenna.
OK:
Antenna cable is securely connected.
NG
SECURELY CONNECT
ANTENNA CABLE
OK
REPLACE ANTENNA OR ANTENNA CABLE (See Installation Manual)
PAGE - 23
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
7
CHECK DTC
(a)
Check for DTCs.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
One of "C0-11", "C0-12", "C0-13", "C014", "C0-15" or "C0-16" is output
"C0-41" is output
A
B
CAUTION: Audio system will display “ _ ”
instead of “ - ” as the DTC #.
B
MOVE VEHICLE TO LOCATION WHERE
RECEPTION IS BETTER
A
REPLACE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER ASSEMBLY (See Installation Manual)
PAGE - 24
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Cannot Change from FM / AM to Satellite Radio
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC and DIAGNOSIS MENU (SYSTEM CHECK MODE)
(a) Start the diagnostic mode
Navigation system: See from page 3
Audio system:
See from page 9
(b) Check the connection condition of the satellite
radio tuner.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
NCON or NRES is displayed, or there is
no display
EXCH or CHECK is displayed
B
OK
C
B
REPLACE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
ASSEMBLY (See Installation Manual)
C
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
(See Installation Manual)
A
2
A
CHECK CONNECTION OF SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
(a) Check if the wire harness is securely connected to
the satellite radio tuner.
OK:
Wire harness is securely connected.
NG
SECURELY CONNECT WIRE HARNESS
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN
IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 25
Noise Occurs Only with Satellite Radio
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUDIO SYSTEM
(a) Check if noise occurs when using other
sources (CD,DVD, AM, FM, etc.).
OK:
Other sources are normal
NG
GO TO VEHICLE AUDIO AND VISUAL
SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
OK
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(SATELLITE RADIO TUNER - ANTENNA AND RADIO RECEIVER)
PAGE - 26
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Satellite Radio Broadcast cannot be Selected or After Selecting
Broadcast, Broadcast cannot be Added into Memory
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SATELLITE RADIO
(a)
Check radio condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Broadcast cannot be selected
Broadcast can be selected, but selection
can be memorized
B
A
2
A
B
Go to step 6
CHECK CONTRACT CONDITIONS
(a) Check if the pay-type contract has been
extended, or if the contract period has
ended.
OK:
Pay-type contract is valid
NG
TO RECEIVE PAY-TYPE BROADCASTS,
CONTRACT MUST BE MADE WITH
THE XM SATELLITE RADIO COMPANY
OK
3
PERFORM ACTIVATION REFRESH BY REFERRING TO
XM SATELLITE RADIO COMPANY WEB SITE
(http://www/xmradio.com/refresh)
(a) Perform activation refresh by referring to
XM satellite radio company web site
(http:www.xmradio.com/refresh/).
OK:
Malfunction disappears
OK
NG
4
CHECK DISPLAY
END
PAGE - 27
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
4
CHECK DISPLAY
(a) Check the display's screen.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
"OFF AIR" is displayed
A
After "---" is displayed, display
B
automatically switches to CH001
Other
C
A
CHANNEL IS CURRENTLY
NOT BEING BROADCAST.
IF BROADCAST RESUMES, SELECTION
CAN BE PERFORMED
(CONFIRM WITH RADIO STATION)
B
CHANNEL BROADCAST HAS ENDED
(CONFIRM WITH RADIO STATION)
C
5
CHECK DTC
• Start the diagnostic mode
Navigation system: See from page 3
Audio system:
See from page 9
• Check DTCs
Result:
Result
Proceed to
"C0-16" is not output
A
"C0-16" is output
B
CAUTION: Audio system will display “ _ ”
instead of “ - ” as the DTC #.
B
REPLACE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
ASSEMBLY (See Installation Manual)
A
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN
IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
6
PAGE - 28
CHECK SATELLITE RADIO MODE ON AV SYSTEM
(a) Check if all preset channels have been erased.
OK:
Preset channels are all erased
OK
Go to step 8
NG
7
ADD PRESET CHANNEL INTO MEMORY AGAIN
(a) Check if the preset channels that have been
erased can be added into memory again.
OK:
Preset channels can be added
into memory
NG
Go to step 5
OK
8
CHECK BATTERY
(a) Check if the battery was replaced.
OK:
Battery was not replaced.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
ADD PRESET CHANNEL INTO MEMORY AGAIN
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
PAGE - 29
Satellite Radio cannot Receive Pay Type Broadcasts
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Some satellite radio broadcast require payment. A contract must be made
between a satellite radio company and the user. If the contract expires, the
broadcast will not be able to be listened to or viewed.
1
CHECK SATELLITE RADIO
(a) Check if CH001 (free broadcast) can be
received.
OK:
Can be received
NG
OK
2
GO TO "SATELLITE RADIO
BROADCAST CANNOT BE RECEIVED“
FLOWCHART (See page 20)
CHECK CONTRACT CONDITIONS
(a) Check if the pay-type contract has been
extended, or if the contract period has
ended.
OK:
Pay-type contract is valid
NG
OK
Go to step 3
TO RECEIVE PAY-TYPE BROADCASTS,
CONTRACT MUST BE MADE WITH
XM SATELLITE RADIO COMPANY
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNER TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
3
PAGE - 30
PERFORM ACTIVATION REFRESH
(a) Perform activation refresh.
HINT:
Refer to the satellite radio tuner company's homepage.
http:www.xmradio.com/refresh/
OK:
Malfunction disappears
NG
OK
END
REPLACE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER
ASSEMBLY (See Installation Manual )
BODY DIMENSIONS
BODY DIMENSION DRAWINGS
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
DI-3
BODY DIMENSIONS
BODY OPENING AREAS (Side View: Rear)
DI-5
DI-6
BODY DIMENSIONS
BODY OPENING AREAS (Rear View)
DI-4
BODY DIMENSIONS
BODY OPENING AREAS (Side View: Front)
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-9
FRAME DIMENSION-Upper Face
(Three-Dimensional Distance)
755
(29.72)
1,286
(50.63)
778
(30.63)
926
(36.46)
1,986
(78.19)
774
(30.47)
994
(39.13)
1,556
(61.26)
1,030
(40.55)
1,263
(49.72)
1,259
(49.57)
1,360
(53.54)
1,041
(40.98)
952
(37.48)
Front
383
(15.08)
300
(11.81)
300
(11.81)
419
(16.50)
402
(15.83)
Imaginary
Standard
Line
mm (in.)
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
Symbol
Name
Wire harness installation hole
Hole dia.
A, a
Power steering tube installation nut
8 (0.31) nut
D, d
B, b
Side rail inner channel standard hole
1616
(0.630.63)
E
Side rail inner channel working nut
8 (0.31) nut
10 (0.39)
C, c
Side rail inner channel standard hole
20 (0.79)
e
Air suspension unit installation nut
8 (0.31) nut
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-10
FRAME DIMENSION-Upper Face (Cont’d)
(Two-Dimensional Distance)
2,033
(80.04)
767
(30.20)
515
(20.28)
387
(15.24)
497
(19.57)
476
(18.74)
515
(20.28)
521
(20.51)
755
(29.72)
1,692
(66.61)
Front
Wheel base
383
(15.08)
300
(11.81)
2,790 (109.84)
300
(11.81)
419
(16.50)
402
(15.83)
Imaginary
Standard
Line
mm (in.)
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
Symbol
Name
Wire harness installation hole
Hole dia.
A, a
Power steering tube installation nut
8 (0.31) nut
D, d
B, b
Side rail inner channel standard hole
1616
(0.630.63)
E
Side rail ilnner channel working nut
8 (0.31) nut
10 (0.39)
C, c
Side rail inner channel standard hole
20 (0.79)
e
Air suspension unit installation nut
8 (0.31) nut
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-11
FRAME DIMENSION-Lower Face
(Three-Dimensional Distance)
995
(39.17)
1,095
(43.11)
795
(31.30)
1,411
(55.55)
1,030
(40.55)
994
(39.13)
1,062
(41.81)
908
(35.75)
1,339
(52.72)
941
(37.05)
1,419
(55.87)
1,456
(57.32)
1,055
(41.54)
Front
284
(11.18)
140
(5.51)
140
(5.51)
320
(12.60)
305
(12.01)
Imaginary
Standard
Line
mm (in.)
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
A, a
Stabilizer bracket installation nut
10 (0.39) nut
D, d
Height control sensor bracket installation nut
8 (0.31) nut
B, b
Side rail inner channel standard hole
1616
(0.630.63)
E, e
Transport hook installation nut
12 (0.47) nut
C, c
Side rail inner channel standard hole
20 (0.79)
—
—
—
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-12
FRAME DIMENSION-Lower Face (Cont’d)
(Two-Dimensional Distance)
2,076
(81.73)
889
(35.00)
515
(20.28)
398
(15.67)
497
(19.57)
470
(18.50)
515
(20.28)
528
(20.79)
995
(39.17)
1,949
(76.73)
Front
Wheel base
284
(11.18)
140
(5.51)
2,790 (109.84)
140
(5.51)
320
(12.60)
305
(12.01)
Imaginary
Standard
Line
mm (in.)
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
A, a
Stabilizer bracket installation nut
10 (0.39) nut
D, d
Height control sensor bracket installation nut
8 (0.31) nut
B, b
Side rail inner channel standard hole
1616
(0.630.63)
E, e
Transport hook installation nut
12 (0.47) nut
C, c
Side rail inner channel standard hole
20 (0.79)
—
—
—
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-7
FRAME DIMENSION
(Three-Dimensional Distance)
1,687
(66.42)
1,082
(42.60)
473
(18.62)
271
(10.67)
1,548
(60.94)
959
(37.76)
1,335
(52.56)
1,325
(52.17)
1,012
680
(39.84) (26.77)
732
(28.82)
680
(26.77)
1,277
(50.28)
1,054
(41.50)
610
(24.02)
959
(37.76)
934
(36.77)
2,119
(83.43)
1,856
(73.07)
1,290
(50.79)
1,287
(50.67)
479
(18.86)
680
(26.77)
Front
371
(14.61)
96
608
105
(3.78) (23.94) (4.13)
232
(9.13)
105
(4.13)
259
(10.20)
300
(11.81)
210
(8.27)
371
(14.61)
Imaginary
Standard
Line
mm (in.)
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
A, a
Body mounting hole
26 (1.02)
F, f
Lower control link installation hole
B, b
Suspension lower arm installation hole
3820
(1.500.79)
G, g
Body mounting hole
14.2 (0.56)
C, c
Shock absorber installation hole
12.15 (0.478)
H, h
Upper control link installation hole
12.15 (0.478)
D, d
Suspension lower arm installation hole
32.514.5
(1.2800.571)
I
Lateral control rod installation hole
15 (0.59)
E, e
Body mounting hole
43 (1.69)
J, j
Body mounting hole
43 (1.69)
43 (1.69)
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-8
FRAME DIMENSION (Cont’d)
(Two-Dimensional Distance)
2,748
(108.19)
2,237
(88.07)
480
(18.90)
506
(19.92)
340
(13.39)
2,324
(91.50)
1,687
(66.42)
294
(11,57)
638
(25.12)
644
(25.35)
340
(13.39)
305
(12.01)
676
(26.61)
570
(22.44)
644
(25.35)
2.053
(80.83)
527
(20.75)
645
(25.39)
83
(3.27)
1,331
(52.40)
Front
Wheel base
371
(14.61)
96
608 105
(3.78) (23.94) (4.13)
2,790 (109.84)
232
(9.13)
105
(4.13)
259
(10.20)
300
(11.81)
210
(8.27)
371
(14.61)
Imaginary
Standard
Line
mm (in.)
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
Symbol
Name
Hole dia.
A, a
Body mounting hole
26 (1.02)
F, f
Lower control link installation hole
B, b
Suspension lower arm installation hole
3820
(1.500.79)
G, g
Body mounting hole
14.2 (0.56)
C, c
Shock absorber installation hole
12.15 (0.478)
H, h
Upper control lilnk installation hole
12.15 (0.478)
D, d
Suspension lower arm installation hole
32.514.5
(1.2800.571)
I
Lateral control rod installation hole
15 (0.59)
E, e
Body mounting hole
43 (1.69)
J, j
Body mounting hole
43 (1.69)
43 (1.69)
BODY DIMENSIONS
Three-dimensional
distance
Center-to-center
straight-line
distance
DI-1
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.
BASIC DIMENSIONS
(a) There are two types of dimensions in the diagram.
(1) (Three-dimensional distance)
Straight-line distance between the centers of two
measuring points.
Two-dimensional
distance
Vertical distance
in center
Center-to-center
Horizontal distance
in forward / rearward
Vertical distance
in lower surface
Imaginary Standard Line
Under Surface of
The Rocker Panel
(2) (Two-dimensional distance)
Horizontal distance in forward/rearward between the
centers of two measuring points.
The height from an imaginary standard line.
(b) In cases in which only one dimension is given, left and right
are symmetrical.
(c) The dimensions in the following drawing indicate actual distance. Therefore, please use the dimensions as a reference.
(d) The line that connects the places listed below is the imaginary standard line when measuring the height. (The dimensions are printed in the text.)
SYMBOL
Name
1
The place that was lowered A mm from the under surface of
the rocker panel centered on the front jack up point.
2
The place that was lowered B mm from the under surface of
the rocker panel centered between 1 and 3.
3
The place that was lowered C mm from the under surface of
the rocker panel centered on the rear jack up point.
Imaginary Standard Line
BODY DIMENSIONS
DI-2
Plate Looseness
Body Looseness
Pointer Looseness
2.
MEASURING
(a) Basically, all measurements are to be done with a tracking
gauge. For portions where it is not possible to use a tracking gauge, a tape measure should be used.
(b) Use only a tracking gauge that has no looseness in the
body, measuring plate, or pointers.
Pointer
Master Gauge
Wrong
HINT:
1) The height of the left and right pointers must be equal.
2) Always calibrate the tracking gauge before measuring
or after adjusting the pointer height.
3) Take care not to drop the tracking gauge or otherwise
shock it.
4) Confirm that the pointers are securely in the holes.
Correct
Pointer
Front Spring Support Inner Hole
Tape Measure
Along Body
Surface
Front Suspension Member Rear Side
Upper Installation Hole
(c)
When using a tape measure, avoid twists and bends in the
tape.
(d) When tracking a diagonal measurement from the front
spring support inner hole to the suspension member upper
rear installation hole, measure along the front spring support panel surface.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-39
BACK DOOR OPENING TROUGH (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the quarter panel removed.
F14063-A
F14063
BP-40
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14064
POINT
1
Inspect the fitting of the quarter panel, bark door and rear combination light, etc., before welding, since this
affects the appearance of the finish.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-49
BODY LOWER BACK PANEL (CUT)
REMOVAL
With the back door opening trough removed.
F14073-A
F14073
330mm (12.99in.)
BP-50
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14074
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-51
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14075
POINT
1
Inspect the fitting of the quarter panel, bark door and rear combination light, etc., before welding, since this
affects the appearance of the finish.
BP-52
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14076
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-53
F14058
POINT
1
Check if the body mounting hole is in the correct position.
2
Vertically tighten the bolt.
HINT:
1) Specified torque for the cab mounts No.1, No.2, No.3 and rear end cab mounts.
NOTICE: Do not reuse the lock nut.
PART NAME
A
Lock Nut (Non-reusable part)
B
Body Mounting Hole
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-47
BODY LOWER BACK PANEL (CUT-H)
REMOVAL
F14071-A
F14071
330mm (12.99in.)
BP-48
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14072
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-20
CENTER BODY PILLAR (CUT)
REMOVAL
F14036-A
F14036
20mm (0.79in.)
45mm (1.77in.)
50mm (1.97in.)
120mm (4.72in.)
270mm (10.63in.)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-21
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14037
POINT
1
After welding the reinforcement to the vehicle side, install the outer pillar.
PART NAME
A
Rocker Inner Front Panel
605mm (23.82in.)
B
Center Body Inner Pillar
C
Pillar Reinforcement
BP-22
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14038
15mm (0.59in.)
BP-72
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
FRAME REAR CROSSMEMBER (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14055-A
F14055
POINT
1
Remove the A at the same time.
PART NAME
A
Frame Rear Crossmember Gusset
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-73
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14056
PART NAME
A
Frame Rear Crossmember Gusset
60mm (2.36in.)
103mm (4.06in.)
119 mm (4.69in.)
141mm (5.55in.)
249mm (9.80in.)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-74
F14057
POINT
1
*1: Air Suspension Compressor Installation Nut*2: Rear Hook Installation Nut
*3: Rear Bumper Installation Nut*4: Frame Rear Crossmember Standard Hole
152mm (5.98in.)
153mm (6.02in.)
157mm (6.18in.)
414mm (16.30in.)
427mm (16.81in.)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-11
FRONT FENDER APRON FRONT
EXTENSION (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the radiator side support, front crossmember removed.
F14013-A
F14013
BP-12
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14014
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-13
F12192-C
PART NAME
Radiator Support To Front Fender Bracket
B
BP-14
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
FRONT FENDER APRON (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the radiator side support, front crossmember removed.
F14009-A
F14009
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-15
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14010
BP-16
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
FRONT BODY PILLAR (CUT)
REMOVAL
F14015-A
F14015
30mm (1.18in.)
40mm (1.57in.)
120mm (4.72in.)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-17
F14016
POINT
1
Remove the remaining foamed from the vehicles side.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-18
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14017
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, weld the A , B and C with standard points.
PART NAME
A
Side Inner Panel
50mm (1.97in.)
B
Front Body Pillar Lower Reinforce
C
Outer Pillar
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-19
F14018
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-5
FRONT CROSSMEMBER (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14005-A
F14005
BP-6
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14006
POINT
1
First install the hood lock support.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-23
FRONT DOOR OUTER PANEL (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14039-A
F14039
POINT
1
Before removing the outer panel, make the installation position with a tape.
2
After grinding off the hemming location, remove the outer panel.
BP-24
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, apply body sealer to the reinforcement, side impact protection
beam and back side of the new parts.
HINT:
1) Apply sealer evenly about 10mm (0.39in.) from the flange and 3mm (0.12in.) in diameter to the outer
panel and apply just enough sealer for the reinforcement and side impact protection beam to make contact.
2
Bend the flange hem about 30 with a hammer and dolly, then fasten tightly with a hemming tool.
HINT:
1) Perform hemming in three steps, being careful not to warp the panel.
2) If a hemming tool cannot be used, hem with a hammer and dolly.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-9
FRONT FENDER FRONT APRON (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the radiator side support, front crossmember removed.
F14011-A
F14011
BP-10
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14012
BP-54
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
LOWER BACK UPPER GUSSET (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14077-A
F14077
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-55
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14078
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-41
QUARTER PANEL REAR EXTENSION (CUT)
REMOVAL
With the back door opening trough removed.
F14065-A
F14065
40mm (1.57in.)
BP-42
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14066
POINT
1
Inspect the fitting of the quarter panel, bark door and rear combination light, etc., before welding, since this
affects the appearance of the finish.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-31
QUARTER PANEL (CUT)
REMOVAL
F14047-A
F14047
50mm (1.97in.)
90mm (3.54in.)
BP-32
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14048
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-33
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14049
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, apply body sealer to the wheel arch.
HINT:
1) Apply body sealer about 5mm (0.20in.) from the flange, avoiding any oozing.
2) Apply sealer evenly, about 3 - 4mm (0.12 - 0.16in.) in diameter.
2
Use waterproof rivets for the A installation.
HINT:
1) Apply the body sealer before installing the A .
PART NAME
A
Fuel Filler Opening Lid
B
Waterproof Rivets
BP-34
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14050
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-35
QUARTER WHEEL HOUSING OUTER PANEL
(ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the quarter panel removed.
F14051-A
F14051
POINT
1
After removing the A , remove quarter wheel housing outer panel.
2
*1 : Reuse
PART NAME
A
Roof Side Outer Panel
BP-36
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14052
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-37
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14053
POINT
1
Determine the position of the new parts by assembly marks of the inner and outer panels.
BP-38
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14054
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-3
RADIATOR SIDE SUPPORT (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the radiator upper support removed.
F14003-A
F14003
POINT
1
Replace the A at the same time.
PART NAME
A
Radiator Mounting Reinforcement
BP-4
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14004
POINT
1
*1: The valve is reference valve.
PART NAME
A
B
Radiator Mounting Reinforcement
Radiator Support To Front Fender Bracket
C
Front Body Mounting Reinforcement No.2
40mm (1.57in.)
180mm (7.09in.)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-7
RADIATOR SUPPORT (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14007-A
F14007
BP-8
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14008
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-1
RADIATOR UPPER SUPPORT (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14001-A
F14001
BP-2
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14002
POINT
1
First install the hood lock support.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-25
REAR DOOR OUTER PANEL (ASSY)
REMOVAL
F14041-A
F14041
POINT
1
Before removing the outer panel, make the installation position with a tape.
2
After grinding off the hemming location, remove the outer panel.
BP-26
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14042
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, apply body sealer to the reinforcement, side impact protection
beam and back side of the new parts.
HINT:
1) Apply sealer evenly about 10mm (0.39in.) from the flange and 3mm (0.12in.) in diameter to the outer
panel and apply just enough sealer for the reinforcement and side impact protection beam to make contact.
2
Bend the flange hem about 30 with a hammer and dolly, then fasten tightly with a hemming tool.
HINT:
1) Perform hemming in three steps, being careful not to warp the panel.
2) If a hemming tool cannot be used, hem with a hammer and dolly.
BP-60
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
REAR FLOOR PAN (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the body lower back panel, lower back upper gusset, rear floor side panel
removed.
F14083-A
F14083
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-61
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F12195
POINT
1
Attach the A to the center of the bearing surface.
2
*1 USA Only
PART NAME
A
Weld Bolt
B
Flexible Hose Mounting Bracket
BP-62
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
REAR FLOOR SIDE PANEL REAR
EXTENSION (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the quarter panel removed.
F14085-A
F14085
PART NAME
A
Rear Bumper Arm Bracket
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-63
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14086
POINT
1
*1: The value is reference value.
PART NAME
A
Rear Bumper Arm Bracket
45mm (1.77in.)
110mm (4.33in.)
140mm (5.51in.)
BP-64
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
REAR FLOOR SIDE MEMBER (CUT)
REMOVAL
With the body lower back panel, rear floor pan removed.
F14087-A
F14087
110mm (4.33in.)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-65
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14088
BP-66
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
REAR FLOOR SIDE CENTER MEMBER
(ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the body lower back panel, rear floor pan removed.
F14089-A
F14089
POINT
1
Leave the A to the vehicle, remove the B .
PART NAME
A
Rear Floor Side Member Center Reinforcement
B
Rear Floor Side Center Member
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-67
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14090
POINT
1
Remove the A from the B .
PART NAME
A
Rear Floor Side Member Center Reinforcement
B
Rear Floor Side Rear Center Member (New Parts)
BP-56
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
REAR FLOOR SIDE PANEL (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the lower back upper gusset removed.
F14079-A
F14079
PART NAME
A
Deck Board Set Support (w / Double Deck)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-57
F14080
PART NAME
A
Deck Board Set Support (w / Double Deck)
BP-58
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14081
POINT
1
*1: w/ Double Deck
PART NAME
A
Deck Board Set Support (w / Double Deck)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-59
F14082
POINT
1
*1: w/ Double Deck
PART NAME
A
Deck Board Set Support (w / Double Deck)
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-29
ROCKER OUTER PANEL (CUT)
REMOVAL
F14045-A
F14045
70mm (2.76in.)
BP-30
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14046
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-27
ROCKER OUTER PANEL (CUT-H)
REMOVAL
F14043-A
F14043
200mm (7.87in.)
BP-28
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14044
BP-70
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
ROOF PANEL (ASSY): w/sun roof
REMOVAL
F14021-A
F14021
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-71
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14022
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, apply body sealer to the windshield header panel, roof panel reinforcement and back window frame.
HINT:
1) Apply just enough sealer for the new parts to make contact.
2
Bend the flange hem with a wooden hammer and dolly.
HINT
1) Perform hemming three steps, being careful not to warp the panel.
BP-68
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
ROOF PANEL (ASSY): w/o sun roof
REMOVAL
F14019-A
F14019
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-69
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14020
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, apply body sealer to the windshield header panel, roof panel reinforcement and back window frame.
HINT:
1) Apply just enough sealer for the new parts to make contact.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-43
ROOF SIDE INNER REAR PANEL (ASSY)
REMOVAL
With the quarter panel rear extension removed.
F14067-A
F14067
POINT
1
Remove the A at the same time.
PART NAME
A
Roof Side To Wheel House Brace (LH Only)
BP-44
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14068
POINT
2
*1 : LH Only
PART NAME
B
Back Door Opening Lower Reinforcement
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-45
INSTALLATION
Temporarily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fitting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F14069
POINT
1
Inspect the fitting of the quarter panel, bark door and rear combination light, etc., before welding, since this
affects the appearance of the finish.
PART NAME
C
Back Door Opening Upper Patch
BP-46
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
F14070
POINT
2
*1 : LH Only
PART NAME
A
Roof Side To Wheel House Brace (LH Only)
B
Back Door Opening Lower Reinforcement
IN-18
INTRODUCTION
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
For convenience, the following abbreviations are used in this
manual.
ABS
Antilock Brake System
A/C
Air Conditioner
assy
assembly
ECT
Electronic Controlled Transmission
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
e.g.
Exempli Gratia (for Example)
Ex.
Except
FWD
Front Wheel Drive Vehicles
4WD
Four Wheel Drive Vehicles
in.
inch
LH
Left-hand
LHD
Left-hand Drive
MIG
Metal Inert Gas
M/Y
Model Year
PPS
Progressive Power Steering
RH
Right-hand
RHD
Right-hand Drive
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
w/
with
w/o
without
FOREWORD
This repair manual has been prepared to provide essential information on body panel repair methods (including cutting and
welding operations, but excluding painting) for the TOYOTA
4 RUNNER.
Applicable models: UZN210, 215 series
KZN215 series
GRN210, 215 series
This manual consists of body repair methods, exploded diagrams and illustrations of the body components and other information relating to body panel replacement such as handling
precautions, etc. However, it should be noted that the front fenders of the TOYOTA model is bolted on and require no welding.
When repairing, don’t cut and join areas that are not shown in
this manual. Only work on the specified contents to maintain
body strength.
Body construction will sometimes differ depending on specifications and country of destination. Therefore, please keep in mind
that the information contained herein is based on vehicles for
general destinations.
For the repair procedures and specifications other than collisiondamaged body components of the TOYOTA 4 RUNNER refer to
the repair manuals.
If you require the above manuals, please contact your TOYOTA
Dealer.
All information contained in this manual is the most up-to-date at
the time of publication. However, specifications and procedures
are subject to change without prior notice.
INTRODUCTION
IN-1
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
1.
WORK PRECAUTIONS
(a) VEHICLE PROTECTION
(1) When welding, protect the painted surfaces, windows,
seats and carpet with heat resistant, fire-proof covers.
Glass Cover
Seat Cover
F10001A
(b) SAFETY
(1) Never stand in direct line with the chain when using a
puller on the body or frame, and be sure to attach a
safety cable.
WRONG
F10002A
(2) Before performing repair work, check for fuel leaks.
If a leak is found, be sure to close the opening totally.
(3) If it is necessary to use a flame in the area of the fuel
tank, first remove the tank and plug the fuel line.
WRONG
F10003A
(c)
F10004
SAFETY WORK CLOTHES
(1) In addition to the usual mechanic’s wear, cap and
safety shoes, the appropriate gloves, head protector,
glasses, ear plugs, face protector, dust-prevention
mask, etc. should be worn as the situation demands.
Code
Name
A
Dust-Prevention Mask
B
Face Protector
C
Eye Protector
D
Safety Shoes
E
Welder’s Glasses
F
Ear Plugs
G
Head Protector
H
Welder’s Gloves
INTRODUCTION
IN-2
2.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS OF PLASTIC BODY PARTS
(1) The repair procedure for plastic body parts must conform with the type of plastic material.
(2) Plastic body parts are identified by the codes in the following table.
(3) When repairing metal body parts adjoining plastic body parts (by brazing, frame cutting, welding, painting etc.), consideration must be given to the property of the plastic.
Code
Material
name
Heat*
resistant
temperature
limit C (F)
Resistance to
alcohol or gasoline
Notes
AAS
Acrylonitrile
Acrylic Styrene
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid gasoline and organic
or aromatic solvents.
ABS
Acrylonitrile
Butadiene Styrene
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid gasoline and organic
or aromatic solvents.
AES
Acrylonitrile
Ethylene Styrene
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid gasoline and organic
or aromatic solvents.
ASA
Acrylonitrile
Styrene
Acrylate
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid gasoline and organic
or aromatic solvents.
CAB
Cellulose
Acetate
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid gasoline and organic
or aromatic solvents.
EPDM
Ethylene
Propylene
100
(212)
Alcohol is harmless.
Gasoline is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts.
Most solvents are harmless
but avoid dipping in gasoline,
solvents, etc.
FRP
Fiber
Reinforced
Plastics
180
(356)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Avoid alkali.
EVA
Ethylene
Acetate
70
(158)
Alcohol is harmless if applid only for short
time in small amounts (e.g., quick wiping
to remove grease).
Avoid gasoline and organic
or aromatic solvents.
Polyamide
(Nylon)
80
(176)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Avoid battery acid.
PBT
Polybutylene
Terephthalate
160
(320)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Most solvents are harmless.
PC
Polycarbonate
120
(248)
Alcohol is harmless.
Avoid gasoline brake fluid,
wax, wax removers and
organic solvents. Avoid alkali.
PA
*Temperatures higher than those listed here may result in material deformation during repair.
INTRODUCTION
Code
Material
name
Heat*
resistant
temperature
limit C (F)
Resistance to
alcohol or gasoline
IN-3
Notes
PE
Polyethylene
80
(176)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Most solvents are harmless.
PET
Polyethylene
Terephthalate
75
(167)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Avoid dipping in water.
PMMA
Polymethyl
Methacrylate
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts.
Avoid dipping or immersing
in alcohol, gasoline,
solvents, etc.
Polyoxymethylene
(Polyacetal)
100
(212)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Most solvents are harmless.
PP
Polypropylene
80
(176)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Most solvents are harmless.
PPO
Modified
Polyphenylene
Oxide
100
(212)
Alcohol is harmless.
Gasoline is harmless if
applied only for quick wiping
to remove grease.
Polystyrene
60
(140)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless if
applied only for short time in small
amounts.
Avoid dipping or immersing
in alcohol, gasoline,
solvents, etc.
PUR
Polyurethane
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for very
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid dipping or immersing
in alcohol, gasoline,
solvents, etc.
PVC
Polyvinylchloride
(Vinyl)
80
(176)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless if
applied only for short time in small
amounts (e.g., quick wiping to remove
grease).
Avoid dipping or immersing
in alcohol, gasoline,
solvents, etc.
SAN
Styrene
Acrylonitrile
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid dipping or immersing
in alcohol, gasoline, solvents
etc.
TPO
Thermoplastic
Olefine
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless.
Gasoline is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts.
Most solvents are harmless
but avoid dipping in gasoline,
solvents, etc.
TPU
Thermoplastic
Polyurethane
80
(176)
Alcohol is harmless if applied only for
short time in small amounts (e.g., quick
wiping to remove grease).
Avoid dipping or immersing
in alcohol, gasoline,
solvents, etc.
TOYOTA
Super
Olefine Polymer
80
(176)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Most solvents are harmless.
Unsaturated
Polyester
110
(233)
Alcohol and gasoline are harmless.
Avoid alkali.
POM
PS
TSOP
UP
*Temperatures higher than those listed here may result in material deformation during repair.
INTRODUCTION
IN-4
3.
LOCATION OF PLASTIC BODY PARTS
Parts Name
Code
Headlight
PC/PP
Radiator Grille
ABS/ASA
Front Bumper Cover
TSOP
Front Turn Signal Light
PP/PMMA
Fog Light
PC/PET
Hood Bulge
FRP
Front Fender Side View Device
ABS/PA
Side Turn Signal Light
ABS
Front Wheel Opening Extension
TSOP
Front Body Mudguard
PP/EPDM
Cowl Top Ventilator Louver
TSOP
Outer Rear View Mirror
ABS/PBT/AAS
Roof Rack Leg Cover
PC
Door Outside Moulding
TSOP
Quarter Outside Moulding
TSOP
Rocker Panel Moulding
TSOP
Door Window Frame Moulding
ASA
Quarter Panel Rear Mudguard
PP/EPDM
Rear Spoiler
ABS
Center Stop Light
PC/PA
Back Door Outside Garnish
ABS
License Plate Light
PC/PA
Rear Fog Light
PMMA/PET
Rear Combination Light
PMMA/ASA
Rear Under Mirror
PC/PBT/AAS
Rear Bumper Cover
TSOP
Resin material differs with model.
/ Made up of 2 or more kinds of materials.
INTRODUCTION
IN-15
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS ON RELATED COMPONENTS
1.
BRAKE SYSTEM
The brake system is one of the most important safety components. Always follow the directions and
notes given in section BR of the repair manual for the relevant model when handling brake system parts.
NOTICE: When repairing the brake master cylinder or TRAC system, bleed the air out of the TRAC system.
2.
DRIVE TRAIN AND CHASSIS
The drive train and chassis are components that can have great effects on the running performance and
vibration resistance of the vehicle. After installing components in the sections listed in the table below,
perform alignments to ensure correct mounting angles and dimensions. Particularly accurate repair of
the body must also be done to ensure correct alignment.
HINT: Correct procedures and special tools are required for alignment. Always follow the directions given in the repair manual for the relevant model during alignment and section DI of this section.
3.
Component to be aligned
Section of repair manual
for relevant model
Front Wheels
Front Suspension (26) section
Rear Wheels
Rear Suspension (27) section
Propeller Shaft
Propeller Shaft (30) section
COMPONENTS ADJACENT TO THE BODY PANELS
Various types of component parts are mounted directly on or adjacently to the body panels. Strictly observe the following precautions to prevent damaging these components and the body panels during handling.
Before repairing the body panels, remove their components or apply protective covers over the components.
Before prying components off using a screwdriver or a scraper, etc., attach protective tape to the tool
tip or blade to prevent damaging the components and the body paint.
Before removing components from the outer surface of the body, attach protective tape to the body to
ensure no damage to painted areas.
HINT: Apply touch-up paint to any damaged paint surfaces.
Before drilling or cutting sections, make sure that there are no wires, etc. on the reverse side.
4.
ECU (ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT)
Many ECUs are mounted in this vehicle.
Take the following precautions during body repair to prevent damage to the ECUs.
Before starting electric welding operations, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
When the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, memory of the clock and audio
systems will be cancelled. So before starting work, make a record of the contents memorized by each
memory system. Then when work is finished, reset the clock and audio systems as before.
When the vehicle has tilt and telescopic steering, power seat and outside rear view mirror, which are
all equipped with memory function, it is not possible to make a record of the memory contents.
So when the operation is finished, it will be necessary to explain this fact to the customer, and request
the customer to adjust the features and reset the memory.
Do not expose the ECUs to ambient temperatures above 80C (176F).
NOTICE: If it is possible the ambient temperature may reach 80C (176F) or more, remove the ECUs
from the vehicle before starting work.
Be careful not to drop the ECUs and not to apply physical shocks to them.
INTRODUCTION
IN-5
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
1.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT THIS MANUAL
BP-34
A
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
QUARTER PANEL (CUT)
REMOVAL
C
B
I
K
A
D
I
J
POINT
1
E
Remove the A at the same time.
PART NAME
A Fuel Filler Opening Lid
A : REPLACEMENT PART AND METHOD
QUARTER PANEL (CUT)
Replacement method
(ASSY) ... Assembly replacement
(CUT) ... Major cutting (less than 1 / 2 of part used)
(CUT-H) ... Half cutting (about 1 / 2 of part used)
(CUT-P) ... Partial cutting (most of part used)
Replacement part
B : REMOVAL CONDTIONS
C : PART LOCATION
D : REMOVAL DIAGRAM
Describes in detail removal of the damaged part involving repair by cutting.
E : REMOVAL GUIDE
Provides additional information to more efficiently help you perform the removal.
F13890A
INTRODUCTION
IN-6
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
BP-35
INSTALLATION
Temporaily install the new parts and measure each part of the new parts in accordance with the body dimension
diagram. (See the body dimension diagram)
Inspect the fiting of the related parts around the new parts before welding. This affects the appearance of the
finish.
After welding, apply the polyurethane foam to the corresponding parts.
After welding, apply body sealer and under-coating to the corresponding parts.
After applying the top coat layer, apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the necked section structural weld spots.
F
I
J
G
I
5mm
POINT
1
Before temporarily installing the new parts, apply body sealer to the wheel arch.
HINT:
1) Apply body sealer about 5mm (0.20in.) front the flange, avoiding any oozing.
2) Apply sealer evenly, about 3 - 4mm (0.12 - 0.16in.) in diameter.
3) For other sealing points, refer to section PC.
H
PART NAME
A Fuel Filler Opening Lid
B Waterproof Rivet
F : INSTALLATION CONDITIONS
G : INSTALLATION DIAGRAM
Describes in detail installation to the new part involving repair by welding and / or
cutting, but excluding painting.
H : INSTALLATIOLN GUIDE
Provides additional information to more efficiently help you perform the installation.
I : SYMBOLS
(See page IN-7)
J : ILLUSTRATION OF WELD POINTS
Weld method and panel position symbols (See page IN-9)
K : PART NAME
F13891A
INTRODUCTION
2.
IN-7
SYMBOLS
The following symbols are used in the welding diagrams in section BP of this manual to indicate cutting areas
and the types of weld required.
SYMBOLS
MEANING
ILLUSTRATION
CUT AND JOIN LOCATION
(SAW CUT)
CUT AND JOIN LOCATION
(Cut Location for
Supply Parts)
CUT LOCATION
CUT WITH DISC
SANDER, ETC.
BRAZE
(Removal)
BRAZE
(Installation)
—
WELD POINTS
—
SPOT WELD OR
MIG PLUG WELD
(See Page IN-9)
CONTINUOUS
MIG WELD
(BUTT WELD)
CONTINUOUS
MIG WELD
(TACK WELD)
BODY SEALER
F13893A
INTRODUCTION
IN-8
SYMBOLS
MEANING
ILLUSTRATION
Assembly Mark
—
—
BODY SEALER
(Flat Finishing)
—
BODY SEALER
(No flat Finishing)
F13894A
INTRODUCTION
IN-9
3. ILLUSTRATION OF WELD POINT SYMBOLS
EXAMPLE:
REMOVAL
INSTALLATION
Weld points
Weld points
Remove weld point and panel position
SYMBOLS
MEANING
ILLUSTRATION
Remove
Weld
Points
Weld method and panel position
SYMBOLS
MEANING
ILLUSTRATION
Spot Weld
(Outside)
MIG Plug
Weld
(Middle)
(Inside)
Spot MIG
Weld
HINT: Panel position symbols are as seen from
the working posture.
F13892A
IN-16
INTRODUCTION
PRECAUTIONS FOR REPAIRING BODY
STRUCTURE PANELS
1.
HEAT REPAIR FOR BODY STRUCTURE
PANELS
Toyota prohibits the use of the heat repair method on body
structure panels when repairing a vehicle damaged in a collision.
Panels that have high strength and rigidity, as well as a long
life span for the automobile body are being sought after.
At Toyota, in order to fulfill these requirement, we use high
tensile strength steel sheets and rust preventive steel
sheets on the body.
High tensile steel sheets are made with alloy additives and
a special heat treatment in order to improve the strength.
To prevent the occurrence of rust for a long period of time,
the surface of the steel is coated with a zinc alloy.
If a body structure parts are heat repaired with an acetylene
torch or other heating source, the crystalline organization of
the steel sheet will change and the strength of the steel
sheet will be reduced.
The ability of the body to resist rust is significantly lowered
as well since the rust resistant zinc coating is destroyed by
heat and the steel sheet surface is oxidized.
2.
STRUCTURE PANEL KINKS
A sharp deformation angle on the panel that cannot be returned to its original shape by pulling or hammering is
called a kink.
Since structure parts were designed to exhibit a 100% performance when they were in their original shape, if they are
deformed in an accident, or if the deformed parts are repaired and reused, they become unable to exhibit the same
performance as intended in the design.
It is necessary to replace the part where the kink has occurred.
INTRODUCTION
3.
IN-17
IMPACT BEAM REPAIR
The impact beam and bracket are necessary and important
parts in maintaining a survival space for passengers in a
side collision.
For impact beam, we use special high tensile strength
steel.
The high tensile strength steel maintains its special crystalline organization by heat treatment or alloy additives.
Since these parts were designed to exhibit a 100% performance when they were in their original shape, if they are
deformed in an accident, or if the deformed parts are repaired and reused, they become unable to exhibit the same
performance as intended in the design.
It is necessary to replace the door assembly when impact
beam or bracket is damaged.
INTRODUCTION
IN-10
PROPER AND EFFICIENT WORK
PROCEDURES
1.
REMOVAL
(a) PRE-REMOVAL MEASURING
(1) Before removal or cutting operations, take measurements in accordance with the dimension diagram. Always use a puller to straighten a damaged body or
frame.
F10007
(b) CUTTING AREA
(1) Always cut in a straight line and avoid reinforced area.
Cutting Okay
Reinforcement
Corners
F10008A
(c)
WRONG
PRECAUTIONS FOR DRILLING OR CUTTING
(1) Check behind any area to be drilled or cut to insure
that there are no hoses, wires, etc., that may be damaged.
HINT: See “Handling Precautions on Related Components” on page IN-15.
F10009A
(d) REMOVAL OF ADJACENT COMPONENTS
(1) When removing adjacent components, apply protective tape to the surrounding body and your tools to prevent damage.
HINT: See “Handling Precautions on Related Components” on page IN-15.
F10010
INTRODUCTION
2.
IN-11
PREPARATION FOR INSTALLATION
(a) SPOT WELD POINTS
(1) When welding panels with a combined thickness of
over 3mm (0.12in.), use a MIG (Metal Inert Gas) welder for plug welding.
HINT: Spot welding will not provide sufficient durability
for panels over 3mm (0.12in.) thick.
Less than
3mm
F10011A
(b) APPLICATION OF WELD-THROUGH PRIMER
(SPOT SEALER)
(1) Remove the paint from the portion of the new parts
and body to be welded, and apply weld-through primer.
F10012
(c)
MAKING HOLES FOR PLUG WELDING
(1) For areas where a spot welder cannot be used, use a
puncher or drill to make holes for plug welding.
REFERENCE:
mm (in.)
Puncher
Thickness of welded portion
Size of plug hole
1.0 (0.04) under
5 (0.20) ø over
1.0 (0.04) - 1.5 (0.06)
6.4 (0.26) ø over
1.5 (0.06) over
8 (0.31) ø over
F10013A
(d) SAFETY PRECAUTIONS FOR ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
(1) When welding, there is a danger that electrical components will be damaged by the electrical current flowing
through the body.
(2) Before starting work, disconnect the negative terminal
of the battery and ground the welder near the welding
location of the body.
F10014
20 30mm
Air Saw
Overlap
F10015A
(e) ROUGH CUTTING OF JOINTS
(1) For joint areas, rough cut the new parts, leaving 20 30mm (0.79 - 1.18in.) overlap.
INTRODUCTION
IN-12
3.
INSTALLATION
(a) PRE-WELDING MEASUREMENTS
(1) Always take measurements before installing underbody or engine components to insure correct assembly. After installation, confirm proper fit.
Body
Measurement
Diagrams
F10016A
(b) WELDING PRECAUTIONS
(1) The number of welding spots should be as follows.
Spot weld: 1.3 X No. of manufacturer’s spots.
Plug weld: More than No. of manufacturer’s plugs.
(2) Plug welding should be done with a MIG (Metal Inert
Gas) welder. Do not gas weld or braze panels at areas
other than specified.
WRONG
F10017A
(c)
CORRECT
POST-WELDING REFINISHING
(1) Always check the welded spots to insure they are secure.
(2) When smoothing out the weld spots with a disc grinder, be careful not to grind off too much as this would
weaken the weld.
WRONG
F10018A
(d) SPOT WELD LOCATIONS
(1) Try to avoid welding over previous spots.
Tip Cutter
F10019A
Old
Spot
Locations
New Spot
Locations
F10020A
(e) SPOT WELDING PRECAUTIONS
(1) The shape of the welding tip point has an effect on the
strength of the weld.
(2) Always insure that the seams and welding tip are free
of paint.
INTRODUCTION
4.
Sealer Gun
IN-13
ANTI-RUST TREATMENT
(a) BODY SEALER APPLICATION
(1) For water-proofing and anti-corrosion measures, always apply the body sealer to the body panel seams
and hems of the doors, hoods, etc.
F10021A
(b) UNDERCOAT APPLICATION
(1) To prevent corrosion and protect the body from damage by flying stones, always apply sufficient undercoat to the bottom surface of the under body and inside of the wheel housings.
F10022
5.
ANTI-RUST TREATMENT AFTER PAINTING
PROCESS
(a) ANTI-RUST AGENT (WAX) APPLICATION
(1) To preserve impossible to paint areas from corrosion,
always apply sufficient anti-rust agent (wax) to the inside of the hemming areas of the doors and hoods,
and around the hinges, or the welded surfaces inside
the boxed cross-section structure of the side member,
body pillar, etc.
F10023
INTRODUCTION
IN-14
6.
ANTI-RUST TREATMENT BY PAINTING
REFERENCE:
Painting prevents corrosion and protect the sheet
metal from damage. In this section, anti-chipping paint
only for anti-corrosion purpose is described.
(a) ANTI-CHIPPING PAINT
(1) To prevent corrosion and protect the body from damage by flying stones, etc., apply anti-chipping paint to
the rocker panel, wheel arch areas, balance panel,
etc.
HINT:
Depending on the model or the application area, there
are cases where the application of anti-chipping paint
is necessary before the second coat or after the top
coat.
Apply the anti-chipping paint after
the top coat.
Apply the anti-chipping paint before
the second coat.
Anti-Chipping Paint
Top Coat
Second Coat
Top Coat
Second Coat
Anti-Chipping Paint
Under Coat (ED Primer)
Under Coat (ED Primer)
Steel Metal
Steel Metal
F10024A
VIEWS OF THIS TEXT
Scope of the repair work explanation
This text explains the welding panel replacement instructions from the vehicle’s white body condition. We have abbreviated the explanations of the removal and reinstallation of the equipment parts
up to the white body condition and of the installation, inspection, adjustment and final inspection of
equipment parts after replacing the weld panel.
Section categories
Each section has been divided as shown below.
Section Title
Contents
Examples
INTRODUCTION
Explanation of general body repair.
Views of weld panel replacement instructions.
Cautionary items.
Views of weld panel replacement instructions.
BODY PANEL REPLACEMENT
Instructions for replacing the weld panels
from the white body condition, from which
bolted parts have been removed, with
individual supply parts.
Front side member replacement.
Quarter panel replacement.
BODY DIMENSIONS
Body aligning measurements.
Dimension diagrams.
PAINT COATING
Scope and type of anti-rust treatment, etc.
together with weld panel replacement.
Under coat.
Body sealer.
Abbreviation of contents in this text.
The following essential procedures have been abbreviated. When actually working, conduct this
work properly.
(1) Jack and lift operations.
(2) Clean and wash removed parts, if necessary.
(3) Visual inspection.
PC-6
PAINT COATING
BODY PANEL UNDERCOATING AREAS
HINT:
1) First wipe off any dirt, grease or oil with a rag soaked in a grease, wax and silicone remover.
2) Cover the surrounding areas with masking paper to avoid coating unnecessary areas. If other areas are accidently coated, wipe off the coating immediately.
3) Apply the first coating of undercoat to all welded areas and panel joints, then apply a second coat over the
entire area.
4) Do not coat parts which become hot, such as the tailpipe, or moving parts, such as the propeller shaft.
5) Besides the locations described below, apply undercoating to all weld points under the body to insure corrosion prevention.
6) Be sure to seal the edge of the flange of the member and bracket with undercoating.
7) If undercoat is damaged by peeling, cracks, etc., be sure to repair as necessary.
8) Before the undercoat apply sealer allowing rust prevention to be attained.
F13902
REFERENCE
Referring to the notes above, undercoating should be applied according to the specifications for your country.
PC-8
PAINT COATING
BODY PANEL ANTI-RUST AGENT (WAX) APPLICATION AREAS
HINT:
1) Whenever adjusting the doors and hoods, apply anti-rust agent (wax) around the hinges.
2) Even if partially repairing a part, apply anti-rust agent (wax) over the entire application area of the part.
3) Wipe off the anti-rust agent immediately with a rag soaked in a grease, wax and silicone remover, if accidently
applied to other areas.
F14028
PAINT COATING
PC-9
F14029
PAINT COATING
PC-11
BODY PANEL ANTI-CHIPPING PAINT APPLICATION AREAS
HINT:
1) Anti-chipping paint should be applide to some areas before the second coat and to others after the top coat.
2) If other areas are accidentally coated, wipe of the paint immediately with a rag soaked in grease, wax and
silicone remover.
F14030
PAINT COATING
PC-1
BODY PANEL SEALING AREAS
HINT:
1) Prior to applying body sealer, clean the area with a rag soaked in grease,wax and silicone remover.
2) If weld-through primer was used, first wipe off any excess and coat with anti-corrosion primer before applying
body sealer.
3) Wipe off excess body sealer with a rag soaked in a grease, wax and silicone remover.
4) If body sealer is damaged by peeling, cracks, etc., be sure to repair as necessary.
1.
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
F14023
PAINT COATING
PC-2
2.
INSIDE
F14024
PAINT COATING
3.
PC-3
REAR LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
F14025
PAINT COATING
PC-4
4.
DOOR PARTS
F14026
POINT
1
*1: Europe Only
PAINT COATING
PC-5
F14027
PAINT COATING
PC-7
FOAMED MATERIAL APPLICATION AREAS
The sections shown in the figure below are filled with foamed material to provide noise insullation.
After repairing these sections or their peripheries, refill with foamed materials
HINT:
1) Use the service holes located on the reverse side of the body panel to refill with foamed materials.
2) When handling foamed material, follow the directions of the material’s manufacturer.
F14031
PC-10
PAINT COATING
SILENCER SHEET INSTALLATION AREAS
F13904
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
SECTION
IV
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
Descriptions of functions for more effective use
Suspending and resuming guidance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
User selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
My places . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Registering memory points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing memory points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deleting memory points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Registering home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deleting home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Registering area to avoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deleting area to avoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Delete previous points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
66
67
67
69
70
71
75
75
76
76
79
80
65
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To resume guidance
1. Push the “MENU” button.
Suspending and resuming
guidance
To suspend guidance
1. Push the “MENU” button.
4U5025G
4U5081G
4U5024aG
The screen will return to the current position
map without route guidance.
2. Touch “Resume Guidance”.
2. Touch “Suspend Guidance”.
INFORMATION
Without route guidance, “Suspend
Guidance” cannot be used.
4U5026G
The screen will change to the current position
map with route guidance.
66
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
Volume
User selection
Voice guidance can be used when approaching a destination.
The volume of the voice or turn off voice guidance can be adjusted.
1. Push the “MENU” button.
The system can memorize the following settings for up to three users.
Map direction
Map scale
Map configuration
Guidance mode
Setup
Volume
Language
Route trace
Travel time/arrival time
Right screen of dual map
Road preference
Maintenance notification
4U5024aG
4U5027G
To adjust the volume, select the desired level
by touching the appropriate number.
If voice guidance is unneeded, touch “OFF”.
The selected item is highlighted.
INFORMATION
2. Touch “Volume”.
During route guidance, the voice guidance continues even if the navigation
screen is changed to other screens.
“Adaptive Volume Control”: By turning
“Adaptive Volume Control” on, the volume is
turned up automatically when the vehicle
speed exceeds 50 mph (80 km/h).
To turn the “Adaptive Volume Control” system
on, touch the button. The indicator will be
highlighted.
67
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
1. Push the “MENU” button.
4U5024aG
To register
When a touch−screen button that is already
registered is touched, the following screen
appears.
4U5083G
4U5030G
2. Touch “Select User”.
1. Touch “Memorize”.
The confirmation screen will be displayed.
4U5029G
2. To register, touch “Yes”. To return to
.
the previous screen, touch “No” or
68
To replace, touch “Yes”. To cancel the re.
placement, touch “No” or
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change user
4U5084G
Touch “User number”.
To delete user
4U5085G
My places —
Points or areas on the map can be registered.
The registered points can be used on the
“Destination” screen. (See “ — Destination
search by Home” on page 26 and “ —
Destination search by Quick access” on page
27.)
Registered areas are avoided at the time of
route search.
1. Push the “MENU” button.
1. Touch “Delete”.
The confirmation screen will be displayed.
4U5024aG
4U5031G
4U5032G
2. Touch “My Places”.
The above message appears, then the map
screen will be displayed.
2. To delete, touch “Yes”. To return to the
.
previous screen, touch “No” or
69
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
8
9
4U5033G
On this screen, the following operations can
be performed.
1
Registers memory points. (See “ —
Registering memory points” on page
70.)
2
Edits memory points. (See “ — Editing
memory points” on page 71.)
3
Deletes memory points. (See “ —
Deleting memory points” on page 75.)
4
Registers or deletes home. (See “ —
Registering home” or “ — Deleting
home” on pages 75 or 76.)
5
Registers areas to avoid. (See “ —
Registering area to avoid” on page 76.)
6
Edits areas to avoid. (See “ — Editing
area to avoid” on page 77.)
7
Deletes areas to avoid. (See “ —
Deleting area to avoid” on page 79.)
70
10
Deletes previous points. (See “ —
Deleting previous points” on page 80.)
Number of remaining memory points
Number of remaining areas to avoid
— Registering memory points
4U5034G
1. Touch “Register”.
4U5035bG
2. Enter the location in the same way as
for a destination search. (See “Destination
search” on page 24.)
After memory point registration is completed,
the “Memory Point” screen will be displayed.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
— Editing memory points
4U5036aG
The icon, attribute, name, location and/or
telephone number of a registered memory
point can be edited.
4U5036aG
4U5037G
3. Touch “OK”.
To edit registered information, see “ — Editing
memory points” on page 71.
INFORMATION
1. Touch “Edit”.
Up to 106 memory points can be registered.
4U5038G
2. Touch the desired memory point button.
3. Touch the touch−screen button to be
edited.
“Icon”: To select icons to be displayed on the
map. (See page 72.)
“Quick Access”: To set an attribute.
Memory points with a set attribute can be
used as a “Quick access” or “Home” button.
(See page 73.)
“Name”: To edit memory point names. The
names can be displayed on the map. (See
page 74.)
“Location”: To edit location information.
(See page 74.)
“Phone #”: To edit telephone numbers. (See
page 75.)
4. Touch “OK”.
71
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change “Icon”
1. Touch “Icon” on the “Memory Point”
screen.
SOUND ICONS
When the vehicle approaches the memory
point, the selected sound will be heard.
1. Touch “with Sound” on the “Change
Icon” screen.
4U5041G
RS02007
RS02008
2. Touch the desired icon.
Turn the page by touching “Page 1”, “Page
2” or “with Sound”.
72
2. Touch the desired sound icon.
The next screen appears when “Bell (with
Direction)” is touched.
Touch either
or
to adjust the direction. Touch “Enter”.
The bell sounds only when the vehicle approaches this point in the direction that has
been set.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change “Quick Access”
It is possible to change attributes of the quick
access points. Memory points with a set
attribute can be used as a “Quick access” or
“Home” touch−screen button. (See “ —
Destination search by Home” on page 26 and
“ — Destination search by Quick access” on
page 27.)
1. Touch “Quick Access” on the “Memory
Point” screen.
2. Touch the desired attribute.
It is possible to replace a registered attribute.
4U5043aG
DELETING “Quick Access”
4U5086G
1. Touch “Del.”.
4U5042aG
3. To replace the attribute, touch “Yes”.
To return to the previous screen, touch
“No” or
.
INFORMATION
4U5045G
One “Home” and five “Quick access”
can be set.
2. To delete an attribute, touch “Yes”. To
return to the previous screen, touch “No”
or
.
73
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change “Name”
1. Touch “Name” on the “Memory Point”
screen.
4U5046G
2. Enter the name using the alphanumeric
keys.
Up to 24 letters can be entered.
3. Touch “OK”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
74
DISPLAYING MEMORY POINT NAMES
The name of a memory point that may be displayed on the map can be set.
4U5044G
To show the name, touch “ON” on the
“Memory Point” screen. To not show it,
touch “OFF”.
To change “Location”
1. Touch “Location” on the “Memory
Point” screen.
4U5047G
2. Touch the eight directional touch−
screen button to move the cursor
to the
desired point on the map.
3. Touch “Enter”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change “Phone #” (telephone number)
1. Touch “Phone #” on the “Memory
Point” screen.
— Deleting memory points
4U5049G
— Registering home
If home has been registered, that information
can be recalled by using the “Home” touch−
screen button on the “Destination” screen.
(See “ — Destination search by Home” on
page 26.)
4U5048G
1. Touch “Delete”.
2. Enter the number using numeral keys.
3. Touch “OK”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
4U5050G
4U5051G
1. Touch “Register”.
2. Touch the touch−screen button to be
deleted.
“Delete All”: To delete all memory points in
the system.
3. To delete the memory point, touch
“Yes”. To cancel the deletion, touch “No”.
75
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
— Deleting home
4U5052bG
— Registering area to avoid
Areas you want to avoid because of traffic
jams, construction work or other reasons can
be registered as areas to avoid.
4U5054G
4U5055G
2. Enter the location in the same way as
for a destination search. (See “Destination
search” on page 24.)
When registration of home is completed, the
“Memory Point” screen will be displayed.
4U5053G
3. Touch “OK”.
To edit registered information, see “ — Editing
memory points” on page 71.
76
1. Touch “Delete”.
2. To delete home, touch “Yes”. To cancel
the deletion, touch “No”.
1. Touch “Register”.
4U5056aG
2. Enter the location in the same way as
for a destination search, or display the
map of the area to be avoided. (See
“Destination search” on page 24.)
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
INFORMATION
4U5057G
3. Set the cursor
in the center of the
area to avoid, and touch “Enter”.
If a destination is input in the area to
avoid or the route calculation cannot
be made without running through the
area to avoid, a route passing through
the area to be avoided may be shown.
Up to 10 locations can be registered
as points/areas to avoid. If there are
10 locations already registered, the
following message will be displayed:
“Unable to register additional points.
Perform operation again after
deleting unnecessary points.”.
— Editing area to avoid
The name, location and/or area size of a registered area can be edited.
4U5059G
1. Touch “Edit”.
4U5058G
4U5060G
4. Touch either
or
to change
the size of the area to be avoided.
5. Touch “OK”.
2. Touch the desired area button.
77
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change “Name”
1. Touch “Name” on the “Edit Area to
Avoid” screen.
DISPLAYING NAMES OF AREAS TO BE
AVOIDED
The name of an area to be avoided that may
be displayed on the map can be set.
4U5061G
4U5106G
3. Touch the touch−screen button to be
edited.
“Name”: To edit the name of the area to
avoid. The names can be displayed on the
map. (See page 78.)
“Location”: To edit area location. (See page
79.)
“Area Size”: To edit area size. (See page
79.)
“Active”: To turn on or off the area to avoid
feature. To turn on the feature touch “ON” on
the “Edit Area to Avoid” screen. To turn off the
feature touch “OFF” on the “Edit Area to
Avoid” screen.
4. Touch “OK”.
78
2. Enter the name using alphanumeric
keys.
Up to 24 letters can be entered.
3. Touch “OK”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
4U5062G
To show the name, touch “ON” on the
“Edit Area to Avoid” screen. To not show
it, touch “OFF”.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
To change “Location”
1. Touch “Location” on the “Edit Area to
Avoid” screen.
To change “Area Size”
1. Touch “Area Size” on the “Edit Area to
Avoid” screen.
— Deleting area to avoid
4U5065G
4U5063G
4U5064G
1. Touch “Delete” on the “My Places”
screen.
2. Touch the eight directional touch−
screen button to move the cursor
to the
desired point on the map.
3. Touch “Enter”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
2. Touch either
or
to change
the size of the area to be avoided.
3. Touch “OK”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
4U5103G
2. Touch the touch−screen button to be
deleted.
“Delete All”: To delete all registered areas to
avoid in the system.
3. To delete the area, touch “Yes”. To cancel the deletion, touch “No”.
79
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
— Deleting previous points
Setup
The previous destination can be deleted.
Setting the items shown on the “Setup”
screen can be done. (See page ix.)
1. Push the “MENU” button.
4U5067G
4U5108G
3. To delete the point, touch “Yes”. To
cancel the deletion, touch “No”.
4U5024aG
1. Touch “Delete Previous Points”.
2. Touch “Setup”.
4U5066G
2. Touch the touch−screen button you
want to delete.
“Delete All”: To delete all previous points in
the system.
80
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
Distance unit
Distance unit can be changed.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
4U5087G
Estimated travel time
The speed that is used for the calculation of
the estimated travel time and the estimated
arrival time can be set.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
4U5090G
4U5091G
3. Touch the items to be set.
4. Touch “OK”.
The previous screen will be displayed.
INFORMATION
To reset all setup items, touch “Default”.
2. Touch “km” or “miles” of “Distance” to
choose the distance unit.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
2. Touch “Set Speed” of the “Estimated
Travel Time”.
INFORMATION
This function is available only in English
or Spanish. To switch language, see
“Select language” on page 148.
81
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
INFORMATION
4U5069G
3. Touch
or
to set the average vehicle speeds for “Residential”, “Main
street”, and “Freeway”.
To set the default speeds, touch “Default”.
4. After setting of the desired speeds is
completed, touch “OK”.
82
The displayed time to the destination
is the approximate driving time that is
calculated based on the selected
speeds and the actual position along
the guidance route.
The time shown on the screen may
vary greatly depending on progress
along the route, which may be affected by road conditions such as
traffic jams, and construction work.
Input key layout
Key layout can be changed.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
4U5092G
It is possible to display up to 99 hours
59 minutes.
2. Touch “ABC” or “QWE” of “Keyboard
Layout” to choose the Input key layout.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
LAYOUT TYPE
Time zone
Time zone can be changed.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
4U5072G
4U5070G
4U5093G
“ABC” type
2. Touch “Change” of “Time Zone”.
The “Adjust Time Zone” screen will be displayed on the display.
4U5071G
3. Touch the desired time zone.
The selected button is highlighted.
“Daylight Saving Time”: Daylight saving
time can be set or cancelled.
To set daylight saving time, touch “ON”, and
to cancel it, touch “OFF”.
4. Touch “OK”.
“QWE” type
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
83
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
Screen layout function (
4U5073G
(Display POI Icons)
Select from among the 6 icons displayed on
the “Display POI Icons” top screen, so that
setting of the icons to be displayed on the map
screen can be done easily.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
“Setup” screen.
4U5094G
2. Touch “Change” of “
POI category change
Function)
Each touch−screen button and current street
name on the map screen can be displayed or
hidden.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
3. Touch the touch−screen button to be
turned off. The button becomes dimmed.
To set the default, touch “Default”.
4. Touch “OK”.
to display page 2 of the
4U5095G
Function”.
2. Touch “Change” of “Display POI
Icons”.
84
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
4U5075G
Display of building shape
When the “Display Building Shapes” feature
is turned on, the system will display the building shape on the map screen using a scale of
150 feet (50 m) to 300 feet (100 m).
To turn the “Display Building Shapes” on:
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
“Setup” screen.
to display page 2 of the
Notifying traffic restriction
When the “Traffic Restrict. Notification” feature is turned on, the system notifies you of
traffic or seasonal restrictions.
To turn the “Traffic Restrict. Notification” on:
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
“Setup” screen.
to display page 2 of the
3. Touch the category button to be
changed.
4U5096G
4U5097G
4U5076G
2. Touch “ON” of “Display Building
Shapes”.
4. Touch the category button to be displayed on the “Display POI Icons” top
screen.
5. Touch “OK”.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
2. Touch “ON”
Notification”.
of
“Traffic Restrict.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
85
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
Voice recognition guidance
When the “Voice Recognition Guidance” feature is turned on, the voice recognition guidance can be heard automatically.
To turn the “Voice Recognition Guidance” on:
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
up” screen.
to display page 2 of the “Set-
Voice guidance in all modes
When the “Voice Guidance in All Modes” feature is turned on, the voice guidance in all
modes can be heard.
When the “Voice Guidance in All Modes” feature is turned off, voice guidance cannot be
heard when using the audio system.
To turn the “Voice Guidance in All Modes” on:
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Auto voice guidance
When the “Auto Voice Guidance” feature is
turned on, the voice guidance can be heard
automatically.
When the “Auto Voice Guidance” feature is
turned off, the voice guidance can be heard
only if the “MAP/VOICE” button is pushed.
To turn the “Auto Voice Guidance” mode on:
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
up” screen.
Then touch
twice to display page 3 of the
“Setup” screen.
to display page 2 of the “Set-
4U5098G
4U5099G
2. Touch “ON” of “Voice Recognition
Guidance”.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
86
2. Touch “ON” of “Voice Guidance in All
Modes”.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
4U5100G
2. Touch “ON” of “Auto Voice Guidance”.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
Pop−up message
When the “Pop−up Message” is turned on,
the Pop−up message will be displayed.
To turn the “Pop−up Message” on:
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
twice to display page 3 of the
“Setup” screen.
4U5101G
2. Touch “ON” of “Pop−up Message”.
The selected button is highlighted.
3. Touch “OK”.
When the “Pop−up Message” is turned off, following messages are not displayed.
4U5109G
Current position/tire change calibration
The current vehicle position mark can be adjusted manually. Miscalculation of the distance caused by tire replacement can also be
adjusted.
1. Touch “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.
Then touch
twice to display page 3 of the
“Setup” screen.
This message appears when the system is in
the POI mode and the map scale is 1 mile (1.6
km) or greater.
4U5110G
4U5102G
2. Touch “Adjust” of “Calibration”.
The message appears when the map is
switched to the dual map screen mode.
87
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
4U5078G
3. Touch the desired touch−screen button.
POSITION/DIRECTION CALIBRATION
When driving, the current vehicle position
mark will be automatically corrected by GPS
signals. If GPS reception is poor due to location, you can manually adjust the current vehicle position mark.
4U5104G
INFORMATION
For additional information on the accuracy of a current vehicle position, see
“Limitations of the navigation system”
on page 198.
1. Touch “Position/Direction”.
4U5079G
2. Touch the scroll arrows to move the
cursor
to your desired location.
3. Touch “Enter”.
88
4U5080G
4. Touch either
or
to adjust the direction of the current vehicle position
mark.
5. Touch “Enter”.
The map screen will be displayed.
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
TIRE CHANGE CALIBRATION
The tire change calibration function will be
used when replacing the tires. This function
will adjust the mis−calculation caused by the
circumference difference between the old
and new tires. If this procedure is not performed when tires are replaced, the current
vehicle position mark may be incorrectly displayed.
4U5105G
To perform a distance calibration
procedure, touch “Tire Change” on the
“Calibration” screen.
The message appears and the quick distance
calibration is automatically started. A few
seconds later, a map screen will be displayed.
89
06 05.24
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS
90
06 06.07
APPENDIX
SECTION
VII
APPENDIX
Limitations of the navigation system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Map database information and updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
VII
197
06 06.07
APPENDIX
Limitations of the navigation
system
This navigation system calculates the current vehicle position using satellite signals, various vehicle signals, map data,
etc. However, the accurate position may
not be shown depending on the satellite
condition, road configuration, vehicle
condition or other circumstances.
The Global Positioning System (GPS) developed and operated by the U.S. Department of
Defense provides an accurate current vehicle
position using 3 to 4 satellites. The GPS system has a certain level of inaccuracy. While
the navigation system will compensate for
this most of the time, occasional positioning
errors of up to 300 feet (100 m) can and
should be expected. Generally, position errors will be corrected within a few seconds.
198
NOTICE
7U5027
When your vehicle is receiving signals from
the satellites, the “GPS” mark appears at the
top left of the screen.
The GPS signal may be physically obstructed, leading to inaccurate vehicle position on the map display. Tunnels, tall buildings, trucks, or even the placement of objects
on the instrument panel may obstruct the
GPS signals.
The GPS satellites may not send signals due
to repairs or improvements being made to
them.
Even when the navigation system is receiving
clear GPS signals, the vehicle position may
not be shown accurately or inappropriate
route guidance may occur in some cases.
The installation of window tinting may
obstruct the GPS signals. Most window
tinting contains some metallic content
that will interfere with GPS signal reception. We advise against the use of window tinting on vehicles equipped with
navigation systems.
06 06.07
APPENDIX
(a) Accurate current vehicle position
may not be shown in the following cases:
When driving on a small angled Y−shaped
road.
When driving on a winding road.
When driving on a slippery road such as
in sand, gravel, snow, etc.
When driving on a long straight road.
When freeway and surface streets run in
parallel.
After moving by ferry or vehicle carrier.
When a long route is searched during high
speed driving.
When driving without setting the current
position calibration correctly.
After repeating a change of direction by
going forward and backward, or turning on
a turntable in the parking lot.
When leaving a covered parking lot or
parking garage.
When a roof carrier is installed.
When driving with tire chains installed.
When the tires are worn.
After replacing a tire or tires.
When using tires that are smaller or larger
than the factory specifications.
When the tire pressure in any of the four
tires is not correct.
INFORMATION
If your vehicle cannot receive GPS
signals, you can correct the current
position manually. For information on
setting the current position calibration,
see “ Current position/tire change
calibration” on page 87.
(b) Inappropriate route guidance may occur in the following cases:
When turning at an intersection off the
designated route guidance.
If you set more than one destination but
skip any of them, auto reroute will display
a route returning to the destination on the
previous route.
When turning at an intersection for which
there is no route guidance.
When passing through an intersection,
there is no route guidance.
During auto reroute, the route guidance
may not be available for the next turn to
the right or left.
It may take a long time to operate auto reroute during high speed driving. In auto
reroute, a detour route may be shown.
After auto reroute, the route may not be
changed.
An unnecessary U−turn may be shown or
announced.
A location may have multiple names and
the system will announce one or more.
Some routes may not be searched.
If the route to your destination includes
gravel, unpaved roads or alleys, the route
guidance may not be shown.
199
VII
06 06.07
APPENDIX
Your destination point might be shown on
the opposite side of the street.
When a portion of the route has regulations prohibiting the entry of the vehicle
that vary by time or season or other reasons.
The road and map data stored in your navigation system may not be complete or
may not be the latest version.
After replacing the tire, implement the
operation described in the “ Current
position/tire change calibration”. (See
page 87.)
This navigation system uses tire turning data
and is designed to work with factory−specified tires for your vehicle. Installing tires that
are larger or smaller than the originally
equipped diameter may cause inaccurate
display of the vehicle’s position. The tire pressure also affects the diameter of the tires so
please make sure the tire pressure of all four
tires is correct.
200
Map database information and
updates
This system uses the maps of DENSO.
2006 DENSO CORPORATION
2005 NAVTEQ. All rights reserved.
2005 Tele Atlas North America, Inc. All
rights reserved. This material is proprietary and the subject of copyright protection and other intellectual property rights
owned by or licensed to Tele Atlas North
America, Inc. The use of this material is
subject to the terms of a license agreement. You will be held liable for any unauthorized copying or disclosure of this material.
Data by infoUSA Copyright 2005, All
Rights Reserved.
2005 VISA Corporation
National Research Bureau 2005
The Bullseye Design is a registered
trademark of Target Brands, Inc.
END USER TERMS
The data (“Data”) is provided for your
personal, internal use only and not for resale. It is protected by copyright, and is
subject to the following terms and conditions which are agreed to by you, on the
one hand, and DENSO CORPORATION
(“[CLIENT]”) and its licensors (including
their licensors and suppliers) on the other
hand.
2005 NAVTEQ. All rights reserved.
The Data for areas of Canada includes
information taken with permission from
Canadian authorities, including: Her
Majesty the Queen in Right of Canada,
Queen’s Printer for Ontario, Canada
Post Corporation, GeoBase.
06 06.07
APPENDIX
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
Personal Use Only. You agree to use this
Data together with the navigation system
for the solely personal, non−commercial
purposes for which you were licensed,
and not for service bureau, time−sharing
or other similar purposes. Accordingly,
but subject to the restrictions set forth in
the following paragraphs, you may copy
this Data only as necessary for your personal use to (i) view it, and (ii) save it, provided that you do not remove any copyright notices that appear and do not
modify the Data in any way. You agree
not to otherwise reproduce, copy, modify,
decompile, disassemble or reverse engineer any portion of this Data, and may not
transfer or distribute it in any form, for any
purpose, except to the extent permitted
by mandatory laws. Data provided in
multi−disc sets may not be transferred or
sold on a divided or single disc basis.
Restrictions. Except where you have
been specifically licensed to do so by
[CLIENT], and without limiting the preceding paragraph, you may not (a) use
this Data with any products, systems, or
applications installed or otherwise connected to or in communication with vehicles, capable of vehicle navigation,
positioning, dispatch, real time route
guidance, fleet management or similar
applications; or (b) with or in communication with any positioning devices or any
mobile or wireless−connected electronic
or computer devices, including without
limitation cellular phones, palmtop and
handheld computers, pagers, and personal digital assistants or PDAs.
Warning. The Data may contain inaccurate or incomplete information due to the
passage of time, changing circumstances, sources used and the nature of
collecting comprehensive geographic
data, any of which may lead to incorrect
results.
No Warranty. This Data is provided to you
“as is,” and you agree to use it at your
own risk. [CLIENT] and its licensors (and
their licensors and suppliers) make no
guarantees, representations or warranties of any kind, express or implied, arising by law or otherwise, including but not
limited to, content, quality, accuracy,
completeness, effectiveness, reliability,
fitness for a particular purpose, usefulness, use or results to be obtained from
this Data, or that the Data or server will be
uninterrupted or error−free.
Disclaimer of Warranty: [CLIENT] AND
ITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIR
LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS) DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES, EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, OF QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
OR NON−INFRINGEMENT. Some
States, Territories and Countries do not
allow certain warranty exclusions, so to
that extent the above exclusion may not
apply to you.
201
VII
06 06.07
APPENDIX
Disclaimer of Liability: [CLIENT] AND
ITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIR
LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS) SHALL
NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU IN RESPECT
OF ANY CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION,
IRRESPECTIVE OF THE NATURE OF
THE CAUSE OF THE CLAIM, DEMAND
OR ACTION ALLEGING ANY LOSS,
INJURY OR DAMAGES, DIRECT OR
INDIRECT, WHICH MAY RESULT
FROM THE USE OR POSSESSION OF
THE INFORMATION; OR FOR ANY
LOSS
OF
PROFIT,
REVENUE,
CONTRACTS OR SAVINGS, OR ANY
OTHER
DIRECT,
INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL
OR
CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES
ARISING OUT OF YOUR USE OF OR
INABILITY
TO
USE
THIS
INFORMATION, ANY DEFECT IN THE
INFORMATION, OR THE BREACH OF
THESE TERMS OR CONDITIONS,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION IN
CONTRACT OR TORT OR BASED ON
A WARRANTY, EVEN IF [CLIENT] OR
ITS
LICENSORS
HAVE
BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES. Some States,
Territories and Countries do not allow
certain liability exclusions or damages
limitations, so to that extent the above
may not apply to you.
202
Export Control. You agree not to export
from anywhere any part of the Data provided to you or any direct product there of
except in compliance with, and with all licenses and approvals required under,
applicable export laws, rules and regulations.
Entire Agreement. These terms and conditions constitute the entire agreement
between [CLIENT] (and its licensors, including their licensors and suppliers) and
you pertaining to the subject matter hereof, and supersedes in their entirety any
and all written or oral agreements previously existing between us with respect
to such subject matter.
Governing Law. The above terms and
conditions shall be governed by the laws
of the State of Illinois [insert
“Netherlands” where European NAVTEQ
Data is used], without giving effect to (i)
its conflict of laws provisions, or (ii) the
United Nations Convention for Contracts
for the International Sale of Goods, which
is explicitly excluded. You agree to
submit to the jurisdiction of the State of
Illinois [insert “The Netherlands” where
European NAVTEQ Data is used] for any
and all disputes, claims and actions
arising from or in connection with the
Data provided to you hereunder.
Government End Users. If the NAVTEQ
Data is being acquired by or on behalf of
the United States government or any other entity seeking or applying rights similar
to those customarily claimed by the
United States government, (i) for acquisitions conducted by the Department of
Defense, the NAVTEQ Data is licensed
with “Limited Rights” in accordance with
the rights set forth at DFARS
252.227−7013(b)(3),
TECHNICAL
DATA−NONCOMMERCIAL ITEMS, and
NAVTEQ Data delivered or otherwise
furnished with “Limited Rights” shall be
marked with the following “Limited Rights
Notice”
set
forth
at
DFARS
252.227−7013(f)(3), and shall be treated
in accordance with such Notice:
06 06.07
APPENDIX
LIMITED RIGHTS
CONTRACT NO.:
______________________________
CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/
SUPPLIER) NAME: NAVTEQ
CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/
SUPPLIER) ADDRESS:
222 Merchandise Mart Plaza, Suite
900, Chicago, Illinois 60654
The Government’s rights to use,
modify, reproduce, release, perform,
display, or disclose these technical
data are restricted by paragraph (b)(3)
of the Rights in Technical Data−Noncommercial Items clause contained in
the above identified contract. Any reproduction of technical data or portions
thereof marked with this legend must
also reproduce the markings. Any person, other than the Government, who
has been provided access to such data
must promptly notify the above named
Contractor.
and; (ii) for civilian agency acquisitions,
the NAVTEQ Data is licensed in
accordance with the rights set forth at
FAR 52.227−14(g)(1), RIGHTS IN
DATA−GENERAL (Protection of limited
rights data and computer software). In
the event that the Contracting Officer
requires the delivery of limited rights
NAVTEQ Data that has been withheld or
would otherwise be withholdable in
accordance with FAR 52.227−14(g)(1),
the NAVTEQ Data is licensed with
“Limited Rights” as set forth in the
following “Limited Rights Notice” at FAR
52.227−14(g)(2) (Alternate II), which
shall be affixed to the NAVTEQ Data and
the NAVTEQ Data shall be treated in
accordance with such Notice (which shall
be marked on any reproduction of the
NAVTEQ Data, in whole or in part):
LIMITED RIGHTS NOTICE
(JUN 1987)
These data are submitted with limited
rights under Government Contract No.
_____ (and subcontract ______, if appropriate). These data may be reproduced and used by the Government
with the express limitation that they will
not, without written permission of the
Contractor, be used for purposes of
manufacture nor disclosed outside the
Government; except that the Government may disclose these data outside
the Government for the following purposes, if any, provided that the Government makes such disclosure subject to prohibition against further use
and disclosure: There are no additional purposes permitting disclosure of
such Data.
The manufacturer/supplier of the Data
is NAVTEQ, 222 Merchandise Mart
Plaza, Suite 900, Chicago, Illinois
60654.
If the Contracting Officer refuses to use
either of the licenses provided in (i) or
(ii), herein, the Contracting Officer
must notify NAVTEQ North America,
LLC prior to seeking additional or alternative rights in the NAVTEQ Data.
203
VII
06 06.07
APPENDIX
END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT
PLEASE READ THIS AGREEMENT
CAREFULLY BEFORE USING THE
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
THIS IS A LICENSE AGREEMENT FOR
YOUR COPY OF THE SPATIAL MAP
DATABASE, INCLUDING LOCATION
CODES AND RELATED PRODUCTS
(COLLECTIVELY, THE “DATABASE”),
USED IN THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM.
BY USING THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AND THE DATABASE, YOU ACCEPT
AND AGREE TO BE BOUND BY ALL
TERMS AND CONDITIONS SET
FORTH BELOW.
LICENSE GRANT
Denso Corporation (“Denso”), as a
licensed distributor of the DATABASE,
grants to you a non−exclusive,
non−perpetual license to use your copy
of the DATABASE for your personal use
or for your use in your business’ internal
operations and not for any other purpose.
This license does not include the right to
grant sub−licenses.
204
OWNERSHIP
The DATABASE and the copyrights and
intellectual property and neighboring
rights therein are owned by Tele Atlas
North America, Inc. (“TANA”) and its
licensors. This Agreement does not
transfer any title or interest in the
DATABASE, except for the license to use
the DATABASE according and subject to
the terms and conditions of this
Agreement. You shall not alter, obscure
or remove any copyright notices,
trademark notices or other restrictive
legends relating to the DATABASE.
The DATABASE comprises confidential
and proprietary information and materials of TANA. Accordingly, you shall hold
the DATABASE in confidence and trust.
You shall take reasonable steps to protect the DATABASE from misappropriation or misuse. You shall not extract
stand−alone data from or publish any
part of the DATABASE without the prior
written consent of TANA and its licensors.
LIMITATIONS ON USE
The DATABASE is restricted for use in
the specific system for which it was
created. Except to the extent explicitly
permitted by mandatory laws, you may
not extract or reutilize any portion of the
contents of the DATABASE, nor
reproduce, copy, duplicate, modify,
adapt,
translate,
disassemble,
decompile, or reverse engineer any
portion of the DATABASE.
TRANSFER
You may not transfer the DATABASE to
third parties, except together with the
system for which it was created, provided
that you do not retain any copy of the
DATABASE, and provided that the
transferee agrees to all terms and
conditions of this AGREEMENT.
06 06.07
APPENDIX
DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY
THE DATABASE IS PROVIDED ON AN
“AS IS” AND “WITH ALL FAULTS
BASIS” AND DENSO AND TANA (AND
THEIR LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS)
EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ALL OTHER
WARRANTIES,
EXPRESS
OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED
TO,
THE
IMPLIED
WARRANTIES
OF
NON−INFRINGEMENT,
MERCHANTABILITY, SATISFACTORY
QUALITY, ACCURACY, TITLE AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. NO ORAL OR WRITTEN
ADVICE
OR
INFORMATION
PROVIDED BY DENSO OR TANA (OR
ANY OF THEIR LICENSORS, AGENTS,
EMPLOYEES OR THIRD PARTY
PROVIDERS) SHALL CREATE A
WARRANTY, AND YOU ARE NOT
ENTITLED TO RELY ON ANY SUCH
ADVICE OR INFORMATION. THIS
DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES IS AN
ESSENTIAL CONDITION OF THIS
AGREEMENT.
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY
IN NO EVENT SHALL DENSO OR TANA
(OR
THEIR
LICENSORS
OR
SUPPLIERS) BE LIABLE FOR ANY
INCIDENTAL,
CONSEQUENTIAL,
SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR EXEMPLARY
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THIS
AGREEMENT OR YOUR USE OF THE
DATABASE, INCLUDING, WITHOUT
LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR
COSTS OF COVER, LOSS OF USE OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION OR THE
LIKE, REGARDLESS OF WHETHER
THE PARTY WAS ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
IN NO EVENT WILL THE TOTAL
LIABILITY OF DENSO OR TANA (OR
THEIR LICENSORS OR SUPPLIERS)
EXCEED THE AMOUNTS PAID BY
YOU FOR THE DATABASE.
WARNINGS
The DATABASE comprises facts and
information from government and other
sources reflecting circumstances in
existence before you received the
DATABASE, which may contain errors
and omissions.
Accordingly, the
DATABASE may contain inaccurate or
incomplete information due to the
passage
of
time,
changing
circumstances, and due to the nature of
the sources used. The DATABASE does
not include or reflect information relating
to, among other things, neighborhood
safety; law enforcement; emergency
assistance; construction work; road or
lane closures; vehicle or speed
restrictions; road slope or grade; bridge
height, weight or other limits; road or
traffic conditions; special events; traffic
congestion; or travel time.
VII
205
06 06.07
APPENDIX
U.S. GOVERNMENT RIGHTS
If you are an agency, department, or
other entity of the United States
Government, or funded in whole or in part
by the United States Government, then
use, duplication, reproduction, release,
modification, disclosure or transfer of this
commercial product and accompanying
documentation,
is
restricted
in
accordance with the LIMITED or
RESTRICTED rights as described in
DFARS 252.227−7014(a)(1) (JUN 1995)
(DOD commercial computer software
definition), DFARS 227.7202−1 (DOD
policy
on
commercial
computer
software), FAR 52.227−19 (JUN 1987)
(commercial computer software clause
for
civilian
agencies),
DFARS
252.227−7015 (NOV 1995) (DOD
technical data – commercial items
clause); FAR 52.227−14 Alternates I, II,
and III (JUN 1987) (civilian agency
technical data and noncommercial
computer software clause); and/or FAR
12.211 and FAR 12.212 (commercial
item acquisitions), as applicable. In case
of conflict between any of the FAR and
DFARS provisions listed herein and this
Agreement, the construction that
provides greater limitations on the
Government’s rights shall control.
206
Contractor/manufacturer is Tele Atlas
North America, Inc., 11 Lafayette Street,
Lebanon, NH 03766−1445. Phone:
603.643. 0330. The DATABASE is
1984−2005 by Tele Atlas North America, Inc. ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. For
purpose of any public disclosure provision under any federal, state or local law,
it is agreed that the DATABASE is a trade
secret and a proprietary commercial
product and not subject to disclosure.
If you are an agency, department, or other entity of any State government, the
United States Government or any other
public entity or funded in whole or in part
by the United States Government, then
you hereby agree to protect the DATABASE from public disclosure and to consider the DATABASE exempt from any
statute, law, regulation, or code, including any Sunshine Act, Public Records
Act, Freedom of Information Act, or
equivalent, which permits public access
and/or reproduction or use of the Licensed Products. In the event that such
exemption is challenged under any such
laws, this Agreement shall be considered
breached and any and all right to retain
any copies or to use of the DATABASE
shall be terminated and considered immediately null and void. Any copies of
the DATABASE held by you shall immediately be destroyed. If any court of competent jurisdiction considers this clause
void and unenforceable, in whole or in
part, for any reason, this Agreement shall
be considered terminated and null and
void, in its entirety, and any and all copies
of the DATABASE shall immediately be
destroyed.
06 06.07
APPENDIX
END USER NOTICE
PLEASE READ THIS NOTICE CAREFULLY BEFORE USING THIS NAVIGATION SYSTEM
The Point Of Interest Data (“POI”
Data) in the navigation system is in
part provided by infoUSA Inc.
(“infoUSA”). By using the POI Data,
you accept and agree to all terms and
conditions set forth below.
1. OWNERSHIP
All rights, title and interest to the infoUSA
POI Data shall be retained by infoUSA.
2. LIMITATIONS ON USE
Except to the extent explicitly permitted
by mandatory laws, you may not extract
or reutilize any portion of the contents of
the POI Data, nor reproduce, copy,
modify, adapt, translate, disassemble,
decompile, or reverse engineer any portion of the POI Data.
3. TRANSFER
You may not transfer the POI Data to third
parties, except together with the system
for which it was created, provided that
you do not retain any copy of the POI
Data.
4. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY
EXCEPT AS STATED HEREIN, INFOUSA
MAKES NO EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT
LIMITATION, ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTY OF FITNESS FOR
A
PARTICULAR
PURPOSE
OR
WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY.
5. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY
EITHER INFOUSA OR SUPPLIER OF
POI DATA SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR
ANY INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL OR
INCIDENTAL DAMAGES MADE OR
ALLEGED IN CONNECTION WITH YOUR
USE OF THE POI DATA.
END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT
Personal Use Only. You agree to use this
information for solely personal, non-commercial purposes, and not for service bureau, time-sharing or other similar purposes. You may not modify the information or remove any copyright notices that
appear on the information in any way.
You may not decompile, disassemble or
reverse engineer any portion of this information, and may not transfer or distribute
it in any form, for any purpose. Without
limiting the foregoing, you may not use
this information with any products, systems, or applications installed or otherwise connected to or in communication
with vehicles, capable of vehicle navigation, positioning, dispatch, real time route
guidance, fleet management or similar
applications.
VII
207
06 06.07
APPENDIX
No Warranty. This information is provided to you “as is,” and you agree to use
it at your own risk. DENSO and its licensors (and their licensors and suppliers,
collectively “DENSO”) make no guarantees, representations or warranties of
any kind, express or implied, arising by
law or otherwise, including but not limited
to, and DENSO expressly disclaims any
warranties regarding content, quality, accuracy, completeness, effectiveness,
reliability, fitness for a particular purpose,
non-infringement, usefulness, use or results to be obtained from this information,
or that the information or server will be
uninterrupted or error-free. Some states,
territories and countries do not allow certain warranty exclusions, so to that extent, the above exclusion may not apply
to you.
208
Disclaimer of Liability: DENSO SHALL
NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANY
CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION,
IRRESPECTIVE OF ITS NATURE,
ALLEGING ANY LOSS, INJURY OR
DAMAGES,
WHETHER
DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES,
INCLUDING ANY LOSS OF PROFIT,
REVENUE OR CONTRACTS ARISING
OUT OF YOUR POSSESSION, USE OF
OR INABILITY TO USE THIS
INFORMATION, ANY DEFECT IN THE
INFORMATION, OR THE BREACH OF
THESE TERMS OR CONDITIONS,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION IN
CONTRACT OR TORT OR BASED ON
A WARRANTY, EVEN IF DENSO OR
ITS
LICENSORS
HAVE
BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES. Some states,
territories and countries do not allow
certain liability exclusions or damages
limitations, so to that extent the above
may not apply to you.
Indemnity. You agree to indemnify,
defend and hold DENSO and its
licensors (including their respective
licensors,
suppliers,
assignees,
subsidiaries, affiliated companies, and
the respective officers, directors,
employees, shareholders, agents and
representatives of each of them) free and
harmless from and against any liability,
loss, injury (including injuries resulting in
death), demand, action, cost, expense,
or claim of any kind or character,
including but not limited to attorney’s
fees, arising out of or in connection with
any use or possession by you of this
information.
END USER NOTICE
The marks of companies displayed by
this product to indicate business locations are the marks of their respective
owners. The use of such marks in this
product does not imply any sponsorship,
approval, or endorsement by such companies of this product.
06 06.07
APPENDIX
There are two types of areas available for
route guidance. In one type of area, primarily around metropolitan centers, detailed route guidance is available for the
entire area. In the other type of area, all
roads are displayed on the map but route
guidance is limited. The navigation route
might lack precision because the data (no
right turns, one−way traffic, etc.) is not
complete. It is still possible to reach the
destination by following the arrow direction and distance as shown on the bottom
left of the screen. The arrow points in the
direction of the destination. The distance
shown is as measured in a straight line
from the current vehicle position to the
destination area.
In order to provide you with as accurate map
information as possible, we are always gathering information such as on road repairs and
carrying out on−site investigations. However,
the names of roads, streets, facilities, and
their locations are often changed. In some
places, construction on roads may be in progress. For that reason, information on some
areas in this system might be different from
the actual location.
— Changing the map
DVD−ROM
6U5025aG
7U5001
2. Touch “MAP
”. The display opens
and the map disc is ejected.
1. Push the “LOAD· ” button.
“LOAD·EJECT” screen appears.
The
7U5002
VII
3. Insert the new map DVD−ROM with the
label side up.
209
06 06.07
APPENDIX
4. Push the “LOAD· ” button to close
the display.
The map database is normally updated once
a year. Contact your dealer for information
about the availability and pricing of an update.
CAUTION
Do not place anything on the opened
display, as such items may be thrown
about and possibly injure people in
the vehicle during sudden braking or
in an accident.
To reduce the chance of injury in the
case of an accident or sudden stopping while driving, keep the display
closed.
Take care not to jam your hand while
the display is moving. Otherwise, you
could be injured.
INFORMATION
Under extremely cold conditions, the
display may react slowly or operation
sound may become louder.
To confirm the database version and
disc coverage area
1. Push the “MENU” button.
4U5024aG
2. Touch “Map DVD”.
RS02001
NOTICE
Do not obstruct the display while it is
moving. It could damage your navigation system.
210
Make sure the version of the database on this
screen. (The database version on the screen
above may be different from the actual
screen.)
06 06.07
APPENDIX
To display the disc coverage area, touch
“Covered Area”. Confirm the covered area
on the screen.
Contact your dealer to find out if there is a
more recent update released.
VII
211
06 06.07
APPENDIX
212
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
SECTION
VI
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
Quick reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Using your audio/video system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Audio/video system operating hints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
VI
151
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
Quick reference
1
2
3
6U5062a
4
5
6
7
152
Function menu display screen
To control the radio, CD changer or DVD
player, touch the touch−screen buttons.
For details, see page 154.
“TUNE·FILE” knob
Turn this knob to move the station band
and files up or down. For details, see
pages 157 and 167.
“AM·SAT” button
Push this button to choose an AM station. For details, see pages 154 and
157.
“FM” button
Push this button to choose an FM station. For details, see pages 154 and
157.
“DISC·AUX” button
Push this button to turn the CD changer,
DVD player and AUX on. For details,
see pages 154, 156, 162 and 171.
“SCAN” button
Push this button to scan radio stations.
For details, see pages 158, 165, 168,
173 and 175.
“LOAD·
” button
Push this button to display the
“LOAD·EJECT” screen or close the display. For details, see page 160.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
8
9
10
“AUDIO” button
Push this button to display the audio
control screen. For details, see page
153.
“SEEK/TRACK” button
Push either side of this button to seek up
or down for a station, or to access a desired track, file or chapter. For details,
see pages 158, 164, 167,172 and 175.
“PWR·VOL” knob
Push this knob to turn the audio system
on and off, and turn it to adjust the volume. For details, see page 153.
Using your audio/video
system —
— Some basics
This section describes some of the basic features of your audio system. Some information
may not pertain to your system.
Your audio system works when the ignition
switch is set at ACC or ON.
6U5001a
NOTICE
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the audio system
on longer than necessary when the engine is not running.
(a) Turning the system on and off
“PWR·VOL”: Push this knob to turn the audio
system on and off. Turn this knob to adjust the
volume. The system turns on in the last mode
used.
“AUDIO”: Push this button to display touch−
screen buttons for audio system (audio control mode).
You can select the function that enables automatic return to the previous screen from the
audio screen. See page 146 for details.
153
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5058
Push “AM·SAT”, “FM” or “DISC·AUX” button to turn on the desired mode. The selected mode turns on immediately.
Push these buttons if you want to switch from
one mode to another.
If the disc is not set, the CD changer does not
turn on.
You can turn off the CD changer by ejecting
all the discs. If the audio system was previously off, then the entire audio system will
be turned off when you eject all the discs. If
the other function was previously playing, it
will come on again.
154
6U5013G
6U5014G
RS02020
The touch−screen buttons for radio, CD
changer and DVD player operation are displayed on the function touch−screen button display screen when the audio control
mode is selected. Touch them lightly and
directly on the screen.
The selected switch is highlighted.
INFORMATION
If the system does not respond to a
touch of a touch−screen button,
move your finger away from the
screen and then touch it again.
6U5020G
You cannot operate dimmed touch−
screen buttons.
Wipe off fingerprints on the surface of
the display using a glass cleaning
cloth.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
(b) Automatic sound levelizer (ASL)
When the audio sound becomes difficult
to be heard due to road noise, wind noise
or other noises while driving, the system
adjusts to the optimum volume according
to the noise level. To turn this function on,
touch “ASL” on the audio control screen.
(c) Tone and balance
How good an audio program sounds to you is
largely determined by the mix of the treble,
midrange, and bass levels. In fact, different
kinds of music and vocal programs usually
sound better with different mixes of treble,
mid−range, and bass.
A good balance of the left and right stereo
channels and of the front and rear sound levels is also important.
Keep in mind that if you are listening to a stereo recording or broadcast, changing the
right/left balance will increase the volume of
one group of sounds while decreasing the volume of another.
(d) Selecting screen size (with rear seat
entertainment system)
6U5012aG
6U5032aG
Touching “SOUND” displayed on the
screen at the audio control mode will display the sound control mode. Adjust the
tone and balance as follows:
To adjust the tone, touch “+” or “−” on the
screen. To adjust the balance between the
front and rear speakers, touch “FRONT”
or “REAR” on the screen, and to adjust the
balance between the left and right, touch
“L” or “R” on the screen.
“TREB”: Adjusts high−pitched tones.
“MID”: Adjusts mid−pitched tones.
“BASS”: Adjusts low−pitched tones.
As the yellow display approaches “+”, each
tone is more emphasized.
Touching “WIDE” displayed on the screen
in the video control mode will display the
wide mode control screen.
“NORMAL”: Displays a 3 4 screen, with
either side in black.
“WIDE 1”: Widens the 3 4 screen horizontally to fill the screen.
“WIDE 2”: Widens the 3 4 screen vertically and horizontally, in the
same ratio, to fill the screen.
When you touch
returns.
, the previous screen
155
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
(e) Your CD changer
When you insert a disc, touch “LOAD” and
gently push the disc in with the label side up.
This CD changer can store up to four discs.
The changer will play from track 1 through to
the end of the disc. Then it will play from track
1 of the next disc.
The changer is intended for use with 12 cm
(4.7 in.) discs only.
6U5003
NOTICE
Do not stack up two discs for insertion, or it will cause damage to the
changer. Insert only one disc into
slot at a time.
Never try to disassemble or oil any
part of the changer. Do not insert
anything other than a disc into the slot.
156
(f) Your DVD player
(with rear seat entertainment system)
The sound of the rear seat entertainment system can be enjoyed by pushing the
“DISC·AUX” button.
(g) AUX adapter
The sound of portable audio players connected to the AUX adapter can be enjoyed.
Push the “DISC·AUX” button to switch to AUX
mode. For details, refer to the “Owner’s
Manual”.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
— Radio operation
6U5060
6U5014G
6U5059
(a) Listening to the radio
Push these buttons to choose either an
AM or FM station.
“AM”, “FM1” or “FM2” appears on the screen.
Turn the knob clockwise to step up the station band or counterclockwise to step
down.
Your radio automatically changes to stereo
reception when a stereo broadcast is received. “ST” appears on the screen. If the
signal becomes weak, the radio reduces the
amount of channel separation to prevent the
weak signal from creating noise. If the signal
becomes extremely weak, the radio switches
from stereo to mono reception. In this case,
“ST” disappears from the screen.
(b) Presetting a station
1. Tune in the desired station.
2. Touch one of the touch−screen buttons (1 — 6) you want and hold it until a
beep is heard. This sets the station to the
touch−screen button and the frequency
appears on the touch−screen button.
Each radio mode (AM, FM1 or FM2) can store
up to 6 stations. To change the preset station
to a different one, follow the same procedure.
The preset station memory is cancelled when
the power source is interrupted by battery disconnection or a blown fuse.
157
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
(c) Selecting a station
Tune in the desired station using one of the
following methods.
Preset tuning: Touch the touch−screen button (1 — 6) for the station you want. The
touch−screen button is highlighted and the
station frequency appears on the screen.
Seek tuning: Push the “SEEK/TRACK” button on either side. The radio will begin seeking up or down for a station of the nearest frequency and will stop on reception. Each time
you push the button, the stations will be
searched automatically one after another.
To scan all the frequencies: Touch “SCAN”
on the screen or push the “SCAN” button
briefly. “SCAN” appears on the screen. The
radio will find the next station and stay there
for a few seconds, and then scan again. To
select a station, touch “SCAN” or push the
“SCAN” button again.
To scan the preset stations: Touch “SCAN”
on the screen or push the “SCAN” button for
longer than a second. “P. SCAN” appears on
the screen. The radio will tune in the next preset station, stay there for a few seconds, and
then move to the next preset station. To select a station, touch “SCAN” or push the
“SCAN” button again.
158
(d) Radio Data System
Your audio system is equipped with Radio
Data Systems (RDS). RDS mode provides
you to receive text messages from radio stations that utilize RDS transmitters.
When RDS is on, the radio can
— only select stations of a particular program
type,
— display messages from radio stations,
— search for a stronger signal station.
RDS features are available for the use only on
FM stations which broadcast RDS information.
6U5015G
“TYPE ”
If the system receives no RDS stations, “NO
PTY” appears on the display.
Each time you touch “TYPE ” or “TYPE ”,
the program type changes as in the following:
ROCK
MISC (Miscellaneous)
INFORM (Information)
EASY LIS (Easy listening)
CLS/JAZZ (Classical music and Jazz)
R & B (Rhythm and Blues)
RELIGION
ALARM (Emergency message)
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5016G
“TYPE SEEK”
When a program is set, “TYPE SEEK” appears. Touch the switch and the system
starts to seek the station in the relevant program type.
If any type program station is not found,
“NOTHING” appears on the display.
RS02021
“MSG” (MESSAGE)
If the system receives a radio text from RDS
station, “MSG” appears on the display. Touch
“MSG”, and a text message is displayed on
the screen. This function is available only
when the vehicle is not moving.
When the system can show the station name,
“RDS” appears on the display. Each time you
touch “MSG” or “MSG OFF”, indication on the
display changes from the band to the station
name, a radio text in this order.
6U5017G
(e) Traffic announcement
“TRAF”
A station that regularly broadcasts traffic information is automatically located.
When you touch “TRAF”, “TRAF SEEK” appears on the display and the radio will start
seeking any traffic program station.
If no traffic program station is found,
“NOTHING” appears on the display.
If a traffic program station is found, the name
for traffic program station is displayed for a
while until a traffic announcement is received.
159
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
— CD changer operation
6U5025aG
7U5001
2. Touch “LOAD”. The display opens.
(a) Inserting discs
The ignition switch must be set at ACC or ON.
Your CD changer can store up to 4 discs.
You can set a disc at the lowest empty disc
number.
1. Push the “LOAD· ” button.
“LOAD·EJECT” screen appears.
160
The
3. The amber indicators at either side of
the slot start blinking. When the indicators change to green, insert only one disc.
After the disc is loaded, the amber indicators at either side of the slot start blinking
again. When the indicators change to
green, you can insert the next disc.
4. Push the “LOAD· ” button to close
the display.
The changer will automatically start playing
from the last disc you inserted.
If the label faces down, the disc cannot be
played. In this case, “CD CHECK” appears
on the screen.
CAUTION
6U5006
Do not place anything on the opened
display, as such items may be thrown
about and possibly injure people in
the vehicle during sudden braking or
in an accident.
To reduce the chance of injury in case
of an accident or sudden stop while
driving, keep the display closed.
Take care not to jam your hand while
the display is moving. Otherwise, you
could be injured.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
NOTICE
The display opens and the amber indicators
at either side of the slot start blinking. After
the disc is ejected, the amber indicators
change to green. A disc can be inserted.
All the discs:
(b) Ejecting discs
A single disc alone:
Do not obstruct the display while it is
moving. It could damage your audio
system.
Do not insert one disc stacked on top
of another one or feed them in continuously, to prevent discs from getting
stuck in the changer.
1. Push the “LOAD· ” button.
“LOAD·EJECT” screen appears.
The
7U5001
INFORMATION
6U5026aG
Under extremely cold conditions, the
display may react slowly or operation
sound may become louder.
1. Push the “LOAD· ” button.
“LOAD·EJECT” screen appears.
The
2. Touch “ALL CD
6U5026aG
”.
The display opens and the amber indicators
at either side of the slot start blinking. After
the disc is ejected, the blinking indicators stay
on.
2. Touch the disc number to be ejected.
161
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
3. Remove the disc.
The indicators start blinking again and the
next disc is ejected.
If a disc is not remove within 15 seconds after
it is ejected, the operation will be canceled.
When all the discs are removed, the amber indicators change to green. A disc can be inserted.
6U5019G
6U5061
The numbers of the trays where the disc is not
set are dimmed.
(c) Playing a disc
Push the “DISC·AUX” button if the discs
are already loaded in the changer.
“CD CHANGER” appears on the screen.
The discs set in the changer are played continuously, starting with the last disc you inserted. The disc number of the disc currently
being played, the track number and the time
from the beginning of the program appear on
the screen.
When play of one disc ends, the first track of
the following disc starts. When play of the final disc ends, play of the first disc starts
again.
The changer will skip any empty disc trays.
162
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
Vehicles with rear entertainment system —
If the DVD player is turned on, push the
“DISC·AUX” button again to switch to the CD
changer.
If the rear seat entertainment system is on,
pushing the “DISC·AUX” button switches the
sound of the front audio system and that of the
rear seat entertainment system.
6U5020G
(d) Selecting a desired disc
Touch the desired disc number on the
screen.
The selected disc number is highlighted.
The changer will start playing the selected
disc from the first track.
6U5020G
(e) Playing an audio disc
Push the “AUDIO” button to display this
screen.
VI
163
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5008
6U5021G
Touch the desired track number. The changer
will start playing the selected track from the
beginning.
SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK
“SEEK/TRACK” button: Use for a direct access to a desired track.
Push either side of the “SEEK/TRACK” button and repeat it until the desired track number appears on the screen. As you release
the button, the changer will start playing the
selected track from the beginning.
“TRACK LIST”: The desired track can be selected from a list. This function is available
only when the vehicle is not moving.
Touch “TRACK LIST”. The track list is displayed.
164
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves up by 6 track groups. If this button is touched when the top page of the list is
displayed, the last page is displayed.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves down by 6 track groups. If this
button is touched when the last page of the list
is displayed, the top page is displayed.
Vehicles with rear entertainment system —
While the DVD player is in operation, the
chapter or track can be changed by pushing
either side of the “SEEK/TRACK” button.
Fast forward: Push “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to fast forward the
disc. When you release the button, the
changer will resume playing from that position.
Reverse: Push “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to reverse the disc.
When you release the button, the changer will
resume playing.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5020G
SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED TRACK OR
DISC
Searching for a desired track —
Touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button briefly while the disc is
playing.
“SCAN” appears on the screen. The changer
will play the next track for 10 seconds, then
scan again. To select a track, touch “SCAN”
on the screen or push the “SCAN” button a
second time. If the changer reaches the end
of the disc, it will continue scanning at track 1.
After all the tracks are scanned in one pass,
normal play resumes.
Searching for a desired disc —
Touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button for longer than a second
while the disc is playing.
“D·SCAN” appears on the screen. The program at the beginning of each audio disc will
be played for 10 seconds. To continue listening to the program of your choice, touch
“SCAN” on the screen or push the “SCAN”
button a second time.
After all the audio discs are scanned in one
pass, normal play resumes.
6U5020G
OTHER FUNCTIONS
“RPT”: Use it for automatic repeat of the
track or disc you are currently listening to.
Repeating a track —
Touch “RPT” briefly while the track is playing.
“RPT” appears on the screen. When the track
is finished, the changer will automatically go
back to the beginning of the track and play the
track again. To cancel it, touch “RPT” once
again.
Repeating a disc —
Touch “RPT” for longer than a second while
the disc is playing. “D·RPT” appears on the
screen. When the disc is finished, the changer will automatically go back to the beginning
of the disc and play the disc again. To cancel
it, touch “RPT” once again.
165
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
“RAND”: Use it for automatic and random
selection.
Playing the tracks on one disc in random order —
Touch “RAND” briefly while the disc is playing. “RAND” appears on the screen. The system selects a track on the disc being listened
to in random order. To cancel it, touch
“RAND” once again.
Playing the tracks on all the audio discs in random order —
Touch “RAND” for longer than a second while
the disc is playing. “D·RAND” appears on the
screen. The system selects a track on all the
audio discs in the changer in random order.
To cancel it, touch “RAND” once again.
If a CD−TEXT disc is inserted, the title of the
disc and track will be displayed. Up to 29 letters can be displayed.
SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER
6U5022G
“FOLDER”: Touch this touch−screen button to go to the next folder.
“FOLDER”: Touch this touch−screen button to go to the previous folder.
“FOLDER LIST”: The desired folder can be
selected in a list. This function is available
only when the vehicle is not moving.
Touch “FOLDER LIST”. The folder list is displayed.
(f) Playing a MP3/WMA disc
Push the “AUDIO” button and touch a
MP3/WMA disc number to display this
screen.
6U5023G
Touch the desired folder number. The changer will start playing the first file of the selected
folder.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves up by 6 folder groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the top
page of the list is displayed, the last page is
displayed.
166
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves down by 6 folder groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the last
page of the list is displayed, the top page is
displayed.
“FILE”: The file list is displayed.
“DETAIL”: Details of the file currently playing
is displayed. This function is available only
when the vehicle is not moving.
6U5008
6U5060
SELECTING A DESIRED FILE
“SEEK/TRACK” button: Use for direct access to a desired file.
Push either side of the “SEEK/TRACK” button and repeat it until the desired file number
appears on the display. As you release the
button, the changer will start playing the selected file from the beginning. When “RAND”
or “FLD·RPT” is on, the file number within the
folder you are currently being listened to appears.
Fast forward: Push “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to fast forward the
disc. When you release the button, the
changer will resume playing from that position.
Reverse: Push “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to reverse the disc.
When you release the button, the changer will
resume playing.
“TUNE·FILE” knob: Use for direct access to
a desired file in the disc.
Turn the “TUNE·FILE” knob to step up or
down all the files in the disc you are currently
listening to. The file number appears on the
display. When “RAND” or “FLD. RPT” is on,
all the files in the folder you are currently being listened to can be stepped up or down.
167
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5023G
“FILE”: The desired file can be selected in a
list. This function is available only when the
vehicle is not moving.
Touch “FILE”. The file list is displayed.
6U5024G
Touch the desired file number. The changer
will start playing the selected file from the beginning.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves up by 6 file groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the top
page of the list is displayed, the last page is
displayed.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves down by 6 file groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the last
page of the list is displayed, the top page is
displayed.
“FOLDER”: The folder list is displayed.
“DETAIL”: Details of the file currently playing
is displayed. This function is available only
when the vehicle is not moving.
168
6U5022G
SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED FILE
Touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button briefly while the disc is
playing.
“SCAN” appears on the screen. The changer
will play the next file in the folder for 10 seconds, then scan again. To select a file, touch
“SCAN” on the screen or push the “SCAN”
button a second time. If the changer reaches
the end of the folder, it will continue scanning
from file 1.
After all the files are scanned in one pass, normal play resumes.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5022G
SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED FOLDER
Touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button for longer than a second
while the disc is playing.
“FLD.SCAN” appears on the screen. The
program at the beginning of each folder will be
played for 10 seconds. To continue listening
to the program of your choice, touch “SCAN”
on the screen or push the “SCAN” button a
second time.
After all the folders are scanned in one pass,
normal play resumes.
6U5022G
OTHER FUNCTIONS
“RPT”: Use it for automatic repeat of the file
or folder you are currently listening to.
Repeating a file —
Touch “RPT” briefly while the file is playing.
“RPT” appears on the screen. When the file
is finished, the changer will automatically go
back to the beginning of the file and play the
file again. To cancel it, touch “RPT” once
again.
Repeating a folder —
Touch “RPT” for longer than a second while
the folder is playing. “FLD.RPT” appears on
the screen. When the folder is finished, the
changer will automatically go back to the beginning of the folder and play the folder again.
To cancel it, touch “RPT” once again.
“RAND”: Use it for automatic and random
selection of the folder or the disc which you
are currently listening to.
Playing the files in one folder in random order
—
Touch “RAND” briefly while the disc is playing. “RAND” appears on the screen. The system selects a file in the folder you are currently listening to. To cancel it, touch “RAND”
once again.
Playing the files in all the folders on one disc
in random order —
Touch “RAND” for longer than a second while
the disc is playing. “FLD.RAND” appears on
the screen. The system selects a file in all the
folders. To cancel it, touch “RAND” once
again.
When a file is skipped or the system is inoperative, touch “RAND” to reset.
VI
169
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
(g) If the player malfunctions
If “CD ERROR” appears on the screen, audio
signals of the disc cannot be read or the system has trouble. Push the “DISC” button once
again.
If the changer does not operate, check that
the disc surface is not soiled or damaged. If
the disc is O.K., the temperature of the changer’s internal mechanism may be raised because of high external temperature. Remove
the disc from the changer to cool it.
If the changer still does not operate, have it
checked by your dealer.
If an MP3/WMA disc contains CD−DA files,
only CD−DA files are played. If an MP3/WMA
disc contains files other than CD−DA, only
MP3/WMA files are played.
—DVD player operation
The DVD player can play DVD video, audio
CD, video CD, CD text, dts−CD or MP3 disc
only when a disc is loaded in the DVD player. A WMA disc cannot be played.
Refer to “Rear seat entertainment system” for
details.
For appropriate discs for this player, see
“Audio/video system operating hints” on page
189.
(a) Inserting the disc
6U5063
Insert the disc into the slot with the label
side up.
An adapter must be used for 8 cm (3 in.) discs
which are loaded in the same manner as for
12 cm (4.7 in.) discs.
170
6U5064
The indicator light turns on while the disc is
loaded.
If the label faces forward, the disc cannot be
played. In this case, “DISC CHECK” appears
on the screen.
If a disc which is not playable is inserted,
“DISC CHECK” will also appear on the
screen. For appropriate discs for this player,
see “Audio/video system operating hints” on
page 189.
NOTICE
Never try to disassemble or oil any part
of the DVD player. Do not insert anything other than a disc into the slot.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5065
(b) Ejecting a disc
Push the
button.
6U5061
(c) Playing a disc
Push the “DISC·AUX” button if a disc is already loaded in the player.
“DVD” appears on the screen. (If the CD
changer is turned on, push the “DISC” button
again to switch to the DVD player.)
6U5029G
(d) Operating an audio CD
PLAYING AN AUDIO CD
CD text only — The disc title and track title will
appear on the screen when pushing the
“DISC·AUX” button.
Push the “AUDIO” button to display this
screen.
VI
171
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5008
6U5193G
Touch the desired track number. The player
will start playing the selected track from the
beginning.
SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK
“SEEK/TRACK” button: Use for direct access to a desired track.
Push either side of the “SEEK/TRACK” button and repeat it until the desired track number appears on the display. As you release
the button, the player will start playing the selected track from the beginning.
“TRACK LIST”: The desired track can be selected from a list. This function is available
only when the vehicle is not moving.
Touch “TRACK LIST”. The track list is displayed.
172
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves up by 6 track groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the top
page of the list is displayed, the last page is
displayed.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves down by 6 track groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the last
page of the list is displayed, the top page is
displayed.
Fast forward: Touch “” side of “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to fast forward the
disc. When you release the button, the player
will resume playing from that position.
Reverse: Touch “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to reverse the disc.
When you release the button, the player will
resume playing.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5029G
SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED TRACK
Touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button.
“SCAN” will be highlighted on the screen. The
player will play the next track for 10 seconds,
then scan again. To select a track, touch
“SCAN” on the screen or push the “SCAN”
button a second time. If the player reaches
the end of the disc, it will continue scanning at
track 1.
After all the tracks are scanned in one pass,
normal play resumes.
6U5029G
OTHER FUNCTIONS
“RPT”: Use it for automatic repeat of the
track you are currently listening to.
Touch “RPT” while the track is playing. When
the track is finished, the player will automatically go back to the beginning of the track and
play the track again. To cancel it, touch “RPT”
once again.
“RAND”: Use it for automatic and random
selection of the disc which you are currently
listening to.
When “RAND” is touched, the system selects
a track in the disc you are currently listening
to. To cancel it, touch “RAND” once again.
If a CD−TEXT disc is inserted, the title of the
disc and track will be displayed. Up to 29 letters can be displayed.
6U5030G
(e) Operating a MP3 DISC
PLAYING A MP3 DISC
Push the “AUDIO” button to display this
screen.
VI
173
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER
“FOLDER”: Touch this touch−screen button briefly to go to the next folder.
“FOLDER”: Touch this touch−screen button briefly to go to the previous folder. To jump
up to the first folder, touch and hold this
touch−screen button until the beep sounds.
“FOLDER LIST”: The desired folder can be
selected in a list. This function is available
only when the vehicle is not moving.
Touch “FOLDER LIST”. The folder list is displayed.
6U5050G
Touch the desired folder number. The player
will start playing the first file of the selected
folder.
174
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves up by 6 folder groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the top
page of the list is displayed, the last page is
displayed.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves down by 6 folder groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the last
page of the list is displayed, the top page is
displayed.
“FILE”: The file list is displayed.
“DETAIL”: Details of the file currently playing
is displayed. This function is available only
when the vehicle is not moving.
6U5008
6U5050G
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
SELECTING A DESIRED FILE
“SEEK/TRACK” button: Use for direct access to a desired file.
Push either side of the “SEEK/TRACK” button and repeat it until the desired file number
appears on the display. As you release the
button, the player will start playing the selected file from the beginning.
Fast forward: Push “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to fast forward the
disc. When you release the button, the player
will resume playing from that position.
Reverse: Push “” side of the “SEEK/
TRACK” button and hold it to reverse the disc.
When you release the button, the player will
resume playing.
“FILE”: The desired file can be selected in a
list. This function is available only when the
vehicle is not moving.
Touch “FILE”. The file list is displayed.
6U5051G
Touch the desired file number. The player will
start playing the selected file from the beginning.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves up by 6 file groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the top
page of the list is displayed, the last page is
displayed.
: By touching this touch−screen button,
the list moves down by 6 file groups. If this
touch−screen button is touched when the last
page of the list is displayed, the top page is
displayed.
“FOLDER”: The folder list is displayed.
“DETAIL”: Details of the file currently playing
is displayed. This function is available only
when the vehicle is not moving.
6U5030G
SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED FILE
Touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button briefly.
“SCAN” appears on the screen. The DVD
player will play the next file in the folder for 10
seconds, then scan again. To select a file,
touch “SCAN” on the screen or push the
“SCAN” button a second time. If the player
reaches the end of the folder, it will continue
scanning from file 1.
After all the files are scanned in one pass, normal play resumes.
175
VI
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
6U5030G
SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED FOLDER
Touch and hold “SCAN” on the screen or
push the “SCAN” button until the beep
sounds.
“FLD.SCAN” appears on the screen. The
DVD player will play the file at the beginning
of each folder for 10 seconds, then scan
again. To select a file, touch “SCAN” on the
screen or push the “SCAN” button a second
time.
After all the folders are scanned in one pass,
normal play resumes.
176
6U5030G
OTHER FUNCTIONS
“RPT”: Use it for automatic repeat of the file
or folder you are currently listening to.
Repeating a file —
Touch “RPT” briefly while the file is playing.
“RPT” appears on the screen. When the file
is finished, the player will automatically go
back to the beginning of the file and play the
file again. To cancel it, touch “RPT” once
again.
Repeating a folder —
Touch and hold “RPT” until the beep sounds
while the folder is playing. “FLD.RPT” appears on the screen. When the folder is finished, the player will automatically go back to
the beginning of the folder and play the folder
again. To cancel it, touch “RPT” once again.
“RAND”: Use it for automatic and random
selection of the folder which you are currently
listening to or of all the folders.
Playing the files in one folder in random order
—
Touch “RAND” briefly. “RAND” appears on
the screen. The system selects a file in the
folder you are currently listening to. To cancel
it, touch “RAND” once again.
Playing the files in all the folders in random order —
Touch and hold “RAND” until the beep
sounds. “FLD.RAND” appears on the screen.
The system selects a file in the folders of all
the trays which are set and plays it. To cancel
it, touch “RAND” once again.
When a file is skipped or the system is inoperative, touch “RAND” to reset.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
(f) Operating a DVD video disc
NOTE: The playback condition of some
DVD video discs may be determined by a
DVD video software producer. This DVD
player plays a disc as the software producer intended. So some functions may
not work properly. Be sure to read the instruction manual for the DVD video disc
separately provided. For the detailed information about DVD video discs, see “(h)
DVD player and DVD video disc information”.
Precautions on DVD video disc
When recording with a DVD video or video
CD, audio tracks may not record in some
cases while the menu is displayed. As audio
will not play in this case, verify that the video
tracks are playing and then activate playback.
When playback of a disc is completed:
If an audio CD or MP3 disc is playing, the
first track or file starts.
If a DVD video or video CD is playing,
playback will stop or the menu screen will
be displayed.
The title/chapter number and playback time
display may not appear while playing back
certain DVD video discs.
CAUTION
Conversational speech on some DVDs
is recorded at a low volume to emphasize the impact of sound effects. If you
adjust the volume assuming that the
conversations represent the maximum
volume level that the DVD will play, you
may be startled by louder sound effects
or when you change to a different audio
source. The louder sounds may have a
significant impact on the human body or
pose a driving hazard. Keep this in mind
when you adjust the volume.
6U5031aG
This “DVD Hint!” screen appears when the
video screen is first displayed after the
ignition switch is set at ACC or ON.
Touch “OK” when you read the message.
VI
177
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
“Hide Buttons”: Touching this will turn off the
controls from the screen.
RS02020
PLAYING A DVD DISC
Push the “AUDIO” button to display this
screen.
When you touch “WIDE”, the screen mode
can be changed.
It you touch “PICTURE” when the vehicle is
completely stopped and the parking brake is
applied, the video screen returns.
6U5035aG
6U5036aG
DISPLAYING DVD CONTROLS
If you touch a part of the screen, where controls are not located while watching video,
DVD controls will appear.
“Page2”: Touching this will display on the
second page of DVD controls.
“Page1”: Touching this will display the top
page of DVD controls.
178
If “ ” appears on the screen when you touch
a control, the operation relevant to the control
is not permitted.
DESCRIPTION OF DVD CONTROLS
Top page of DVD video controls
“Menu” and “Top Menu”: If you touch any
of the above controls, the menu screen for
DVD video appears. (For the operation, see
the manual that come with the DVD video disc
provided separately.)
: The menu control key appears on the
screen. (See page 179.)
: Touching this will pause the video
screen. When you touch this again, the video
screen advances frame by frame.
: Touching this will fast reverse during
playback.
: Touching this will stop the video screen.
: Touching this will pause during playback
and resume normal play during pause or slow
forward.
: Touching this will fast forward during
playback and forward slowly during pause.
06 05.26
AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM
Second page of DVD video controls
“Setup”: The initial set up screen appears.
(See page 181.)
“Search”: The title search screen appears.
(See page 179.)
“Return”: Touching this will display the predetermined scene and start playing from
there.
“AUDIO”: The audio changing screen appears. (See page 180.)
“Subtitle”: The subtitle changing screen appears. (See page 180.)
“Angle”: The angle selection screen appears. (See page 180.)
6U5037aG
SELECTING A MENU ITEM
Enter the menu item using , , and
and touch “Enter”. The player starts playing video for that menu item. (For details,
see the manual that comes with the DVD
video disc provided separately.)
Each time you touch “Move Buttons”, the
controls on the screen move upward and
downward.
When you touch “< > > ON
[ENTER] to Customize
[EXIT] to Quit
Page 3 of 4
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHTS – EL014-06
Activation
Procedure
(Continued)
10. In the “SETTING CHANGE DRL
FUNCTION” screen, press the
“YES” button.
December 12, 2006
SETTING CHANGE
DRL FUNCTION
ARE YOU SURE YOU
WANT TO CHANGE
From
To
ON
OFF
[YES]
[NO]
11. Verify that the Daytime Running
Lights (DRL) have been deactivated.
?
to Change
to Abort
CUSTOMIZE COMPLETE
DRL FUNCTION
The setting has
been changed to:
ON
Confirm the item
operation is as
desired.
PRESS [ENTER]
Page 4 of 4
REAR DRIVESHAFT/PROPELLER SHAFT
CLUNK/THUMP NOISE
Technical Service
Information Bulletin
Models:
’03 – ’07 GX 470
May 29, 2007
TSIB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSIB supercedes TSIB No. DL001-06.
TSIB No. DL001-06 is now obsolete and should be discarded.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Some owners of 2003 – 2007 model year GX 470 vehicles may experience a
clunk/thump noise from the rear of the vehicle or a “bump-from-behind” sensation just
before or after coming to a stop. A new rear propeller shaft assembly and revised rear
suspension control arms have been developed to improve this condition.
S 2003 – 2007 model year GX 470 vehicles.
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
37110–6A480
37110–60A40
Shaft Assembly, Propeller (DLC)
1
N/A
04006–09160
Rear Suspension Control Arm Kit
1
Required
Tools &
Material
Warranty
Information
TOOLS & MATERIAL
QUANTITY
Miscellaneous Hand Tools
As Needed
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
DL5005
R & R Rear Driveshaft Assembly, Lower
Control Arms, and Upper Control Arms
2.5
37110–6A480
T1
T2
91 50
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Lexus Powertrain Warranty. This warranty is
in effect for 72 months or 70,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Lexus Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
DRIVELINE & DIFFERENTIAL
DL002-07
Title:
REAR DRIVESHAFT/PROPELLER SHAFT CLUNK/THUMP NOISE – DL002-07
Repair
Procedure
May 29, 2007
1. Test drive vehicle and confirm noise condition.
NOTE:
Check for the painted matchmarks on the transfer flange and differential flange when
installing the NEW propeller shaft assembly. If the matchmarks are NOT visible, be sure
to install the NEW propeller shaft in the same orientation as the original propeller shaft.
2. Remove and replace the 2-piece propeller shaft assembly.
For more information, refer to the Technical Information System (TIS):
S 2003, 2004, or 2005 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Drivetrain –
Driveshaft/Propeller Shaft – “Propeller Shaft Assy: Overhaul”.
S 2006 or 2007 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Drivetrain –
Driveshaft/Propeller Shaft – “Propeller Shaft: Propeller Shaft Assembly:
Removal”.
S 2006 or 2007 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Drivetrain –
Driveshaft/Propeller Shaft – “Propeller Shaft: Propeller Shaft
Assembly: Installation”.
A. Remove the propeller
shaft assembly.
a. Remove the 4 nuts and
4 washers.
Matchmarks
b. Remove the 4 nuts, 4 bolts,
and 4 washers and then the
propeller shaft assembly.
Matchmarks
Page 2 of 4
REAR DRIVESHAFT/PROPELLER SHAFT CLUNK/THUMP NOISE – DL002-07
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
May 29, 2007
B. Install the NEW propeller
shaft assembly.
a. Align the matchmarks on
the yoke and the
differential flange.
b. Install the propeller shaft
assembly with the 4 bolts,
4 nuts, and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 NSm
(898 kgfScm, 65 ftSlbf)
Matchmarks
c. Align the matchmarks on
the yoke and the
transfer flange.
d. Install the propeller shaft
assembly with the 4 nuts
and 4 washers.
Torque: 88 NSm
(898 kgfScm, 65 ftSlbf)
Matchmarks
3. Remove and replace the LH and RH upper control arm assemblies one side at a time.
Refer to TIS:
S 2003, 2004, or 2005 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Suspension – Rear
Suspension – “Upper Control Arm Assy: Replacement”.
S 2006 or 2007 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Suspension – Rear Suspension
– “Suspension: Rear Upper Control Arm: Removal”.
S 2006 or 2007 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Suspension – Rear Suspension
– “Suspension: Rear Upper Control Arm: Installation”.
Upper Control Arm Identification
LEFT Upper Control Arm has
YELLOW Paint Mark
RIGHT Upper Control Arm has
BLUE Paint Mark
Page 3 of 4
REAR DRIVESHAFT/PROPELLER SHAFT CLUNK/THUMP NOISE – DL002-07
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
May 29, 2007
4. Remove and replace the LH and RH lower control arm assemblies one side at a time.
Refer to TIS:
S 2003, 2004, or 2005 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Suspension – Rear
Suspension – “Lower Control Arm Assy LH: Replacement”.
S 2006 or 2007 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Suspension – Rear Suspension
– “Suspension: Rear Lower Control Arm: Removal”.
S 2006 or 2007 model year GX 470 Repair Manual, Suspension – Rear
Suspension – “Suspension: Rear Lower Control Arm: Installation”.
Lower Control Arm Identification
LEFT Lower Control Arm
RIGHT Lower Control Arm
Hole in Bushing
Frame Side
Hole in Bushing
Bushing
Bushing
Front of Vehicle
Axle Side
5. Test drive vehicle and confirm repair effectiveness.
Page 4 of 4
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SECOND ROW SEAT BACK NOISE
Models:
’03 – ’07 4Runner
March 22, 2004
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S April 11, 2007: 2007 model year has been added to Applicable Vehicles.
S March 17, 2006: 2004 – 2006 model years have been added to Applicable Vehicles.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
The following field-fix procedure was developed to minimize the possibility of noise from
the second row passenger side (right side) seat back latch.
S 2003 – 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
NV4002
Adjust Second Row Passenger Side
(Right Side) Seat Back Striker**
1.0
72601–35020
T1
T2
91 57
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
** This field-fix procedure applies to the second row passenger side (right side) ONLY. This procedure
does NOT apply to the second row driver side (left side).
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
NVH
NV003-04
Title:
SECOND ROW SEAT BACK NOISE – NV003-04 Revised
Repair
Procedure
March 22, 2004
For reference refer to the Technical Information System (TIS), applicable model year
4Runner Repair Manual: Exterior/interior Trim: Roof Headlining Assy: Replacement.
1. Check passenger side second row
seat back latch to striker alignment.
2. Determine if the striker is centered in
the seat back latch by slowly moving
the passenger side second seat back
toward the striker. Visually check to
see if the striker is centered in the
seat back latch.
HINT:
Wear marks on the top or bottom
portion of the striker indicate a
possible misalignment issue. If wear
marks are found to be on top of the
striker, the striker must be adjusted
downward to remedy the condition
and vice versa.
Wear Marks
3. If striker misalignment is detected, continue with step 4.
If the striker is found to be centered in the seat latch and there are NO wear marks
evident on the top or bottom surfaces of the striker, the following field fix will NOT
be effective.
4. Remove the passenger side second row seat back striker and elongate the bottom
mounting hole to allow striker adjustment.
(For necessary interior disassembly instructions to access the second row seat back
striker, refer to TIS, applicable model year 4Runner Repair Manual: Exterior/interior
Trim: Roof Headlining Assy: Replacement: steps 1 – 23).
A. Remove the three bolts that secure the second row seat back latch striker to the
vehicle body.
B. Remove 1 mm of striker plate
material from the top and bottom
of the bottom striker plate bolt
hole to elongate the hole and
create striker adjustability as
shown in the illustration.
Bottom Hole
Elongate hole by removing 1 mm of striker plate
material from top and bottom of the bottom hole.
Page 2 of 3
SECOND ROW SEAT BACK NOISE – NV003-04 Revised
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
March 22, 2004
5. Reinstall striker to vehicle body and
adjust striker to center of seat latch.
A. Install the passenger side second
row seat back striker by threading
each of the three (3) bolts into the
body. Do NOT tighten the three
(3) bolts at this time.
B. Rotate the seat back toward the
striker and align the striker in the
center of the seat back latch.
C. Tighten the three (3) bolts to
secure the striker in place.
6. Reassemble the vehicle interior in
reverse order of disassembly.
For reference, refer TIS, applicable
model year 4Runner Repair Manual:
Exterior/interior Trim: Roof Headlining
Assy: Replacement.
Page 3 of 3
FRONT SEAT SQUEAK NOISE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’04 – ’07 Toyota & Scion
May 23, 2006
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Material
Warranty
Information
Some customers may experience a squeak noise due to contact between the seat track
locating pin(s) and the floor pan location hole(s). The following procedure describes the
repair method to correct this condition.
S 2004 – 2007 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
TOOLS & MATERIAL
QUANTITY
Flat Blade Screwdriver (Taped Tip)
1
Power Cut-off Tool (or equivalent)
1
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
NV5011
R & R Front Seat Track Pins (1 seat)
0.5
Combo A
Opposite Side
0.5
OFP
72011–#####
72012–#####
T1
T2
91 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 5
NVH
NV004-06
Title:
FRONT SEAT SQUEAK NOISE – NV004-06
Pin Location
Parts
Location
May 23, 2006
The following table indicates the location and the number of seat track locating pins that
should be removed from the seat track assembly:
MODEL
NUMBER OF PINS TO REMOVE
PIN LOCATION
4Runner
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Avalon
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Camry
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Corolla
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Echo
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
FJ Cruiser
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Highlander
1 (Inner Side ONLY)
Front & Inner Track ONLY
Land Cruiser
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Matrix
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Prius
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
RAV4
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Scion tC
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Scion xA
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Scion xB
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Sequoia
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Sienna
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Solara
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Tacoma
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Tundra
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Yaris
2
Front, Inner, & Outer Track
Typical View of Driver’s Side Seat
Inner Seat Track
Seat Track Locating Pin
Page 2 of 5
Outer Seat Track
FRONT SEAT SQUEAK NOISE – NV004-06
Repair
Procedure
May 23, 2006
CAUTION:
S Wear safety gloves to prevent injury to your hands.
S Work must be started more than 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to
the LOCK position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the
battery. (The SRS is equipped with a backup power source. If work is started within
90 seconds from disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the
SRS may deploy.)
S The yaw rate sensor is installed under the front RH seat. Be careful NOT to step on
the yaw rate sensor after the seat has been removed.
HINT:
S The installation is the reverse order of removal. However, when there is a special
point concerning installation, it is indicated.
S Use the same procedure on the RH side as on the LH side.
S When removing/installing and performing repairs on the passenger seat, perform
the Occupant Classification System Zero Point Calibration as outlined in the
Diagnostics section of the applicable model year Repair Manual for each model.
1. Disconnect the negative (–) battery terminal.
2. Remove the plastic front seat track
covers — Use a screwdriver to
disengage the claws and carefully
remove the plastic seat track covers.
Typical Outer Seat Track Cover
NOTE:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate Toyota or
Scion Repair Manual for each model for
detailed instructions on how to remove
the plastic seat track covers.
Typical Inner Seat Track Cover
: Claw
Page 3 of 5
FRONT SEAT SQUEAK NOISE – NV004-06
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
May 23, 2006
3. Remove the plastic rear seat track
covers — Use the taped screwdriver
to disengage the claws and carefully
remove the plastic seat track covers.
4. Remove the LH front seat assembly.
A. Move the seatback to the full
upright position.
B. Remove the four (4) seat track
securing bolts.
: Claw
C. Disconnect the electrical
connectors and remove the
complete seat assembly.
5. Remove the seat track locating pins.
A. With the seat removed from the
vehicle, tilt the seat assembly
backward to gain access to the
seat track locating pins.
Seat Rail
Cut Off at
2 mm or
Less
Seat Locator Pin
B. Use a power cut-off tool (or
equivalent) to cut off the two (2)
locating pins leaving 2 mm
(0.1 in.) or less of each pin.
Front Floor Cross Member
IMPORTANT:
Do NOT permit the power cut-off tool to contact the seat track. ONLY cut off the
shaft of the pin (near the base of the seat track).
NOTE:
The seat track locating pins’ function is to ease installation during manufacturing and
does NOT provide any other function.
6. Clean and paint bare metal surfaces.
A. Remove any metal shavings from the seat track/seat assembly.
B. Clean the bare metal surface of the remainder of the seat track locating pin with
wax, grease, and silicone remover.
C. To prevent corrosion, coat any bare metal surfaces still attached to the seat track
with a brush-on type paint.
7. Install LH front seat assembly.
A. Place the seat on the cabin floor.
B. Reconnect all electrical connectors under the seat.
C. Install all four (4) seat track retaining bolts (fingertight).
Page 4 of 5
FRONT SEAT SQUEAK NOISE – NV004-06
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
May 23, 2006
D. Tighten the two (2) front seat track attaching bolts.
NOTE:
The bolt torque specification varies by model. Please refer to the Repair Manual for
the correct bolt torque for the model you are working on.
E. Tighten the two (2) rear seat track attaching bolts.
NOTE:
The bolt torque specification varies by model. Please refer to the Repair Manual for
the correct bolt torque for the model you are working on.
F. Reinstall all plastic seat track covers.
8. Repeat steps 1 – 6 for the RH seat assembly.
9. Reconnect the negative (–) battery terminal.
10. Test power seat operation and seat heater (if equipped) for proper operation.
11. Initialize front passenger occupant classification system and re-initialize any other
power systems.
S Refer to TSB No. PD008-05, “Power System Initialization During PDS.”
S Refer to TSB No. PD014-06, “Power System Initialization During PDS.”
12. Inspect SRS warning light operation.
13. Test drive vehicle and confirm that the seat squeak has been eliminated.
Page 5 of 5
Technical Service
BULLETIN
September 18, 2006
Introduction
UPPER/LOWER WINDSHIELD
TICK NOISE
Models:
’03 – ’07 Toyota & ’04 – ’07 Scion
If a creak, tick, or rattle noise is heard at the top or bottom of the windshield, the source
of the noise may be the two windshield stoppers bonded to the top of the windshield or
the windshield retainers bonded to the lower edge of the windshield. This bulletin
provides the recommended repair procedure to eliminate these types of noises from the
windshield area.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have both stoppers and retainers while others may only have stoppers
at the top of the windshield. Use the chart in this bulletin to determine the location of
the windshield holding devices.
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Material
S 2003 – 2007 model year Toyota vehicles.
S 2004 – 2007 model year Scion vehicles.
TOOLS & MATERIAL
QUANTITY
–
1
Snap-On H55A
1
T1
Basic Hand Tools
Hacksaw “Mini” for 10-in. Blades (or equivalent)
Warranty
Information
PART NUMBER
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
NV5019
Remove Top Windshield Locating Pins (2)
0.4
56116–#####
NV5020
Remove Bottom Windshield Locating Pins (2)
0.3
56114–#####
T2
91 41
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 6
NVH
NV009-06
Title:
UPPER/LOWER WINDSHIELD TICK NOISE – NV009-06
Required
SSTs
ITEM
NO.
1
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
Plastic Pry Tool Set*
September 18, 2006
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
00002–06000–01
1
20
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
COMPONENT(S)
OF KIT/SET
S Plastic Panel Clip Removal Tool
(P/N 00002–06001–01)
S Plastic Emblem Removal Tool
(P/N 00002–06002–01)
* Essential SSTs.
** Drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Page 2 of 6
UPPER/LOWER WINDSHIELD TICK NOISE – NV009-06
Pin
Locations
September 18, 2006
PIN LOCATION
MODEL
TOP OF WINDSHIELD
QTY
BOTTOM OF WINDSHIELD
QTY
4Runner
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Avalon
Yes
2
Yes
2
Camry (All Models)
Yes
2
Yes
2
Celica
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Corolla
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
ECHO
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
FJ Cruiser
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Highlander
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Land Cruiser
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Matrix
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
MR2 Spyder
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Prius
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
RAV4
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Scion tC
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Scion xA
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Scion xB
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Sequoia
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Sienna
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Solara
Yes
2
Yes
2
Tacoma
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Tundra
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Yaris
Yes
2
N/A
N/A
Pin Locations
Page 3 of 6
UPPER/LOWER WINDSHIELD TICK NOISE – NV009-06
Repair
Procedure
September 18, 2006
Upper Windshield Glass Stoppers:
1. Remove both sun visors and both A-pillar garnishes, and then carefully lower the front
of the headliner to gain access to the windshield stoppers (refer to the appropriate
model year Repair Manual for the proper procedure).
NOTE:
It is very important that the front of the headliner be lowered carefully and slowly.
Applying too much downward force on the headliner will cause it to develop a
permanent crease in the surface material.
The stoppers are located on the inside of the passenger compartment behind the
windshield glass blackout section (near the top front edge of the metal roof opening).
The stoppers are typically located 20 – 25 cm (7.9 – 9.8 in.) inboard of the top
corners of the windshield glass.
2. Cut OFF the tip of the plastic stopper as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
It is sometimes necessary to bend the metal body tab down to gain access to the shaft
of the stopper.
20 – 25 cm
(7.9 – 9.8 in.)
20 – 25 cm
(7.9 – 9.8 in.)
Windshield Glass
Roof Panel
Glass Stopper
Windshield Glass
Roof Panel
Fragment of Glass Stopper
Glass Stopper
Page 4 of 6
Cut
UPPER/LOWER WINDSHIELD TICK NOISE – NV009-06
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
September 18, 2006
3. Once the tip of the stopper has been removed, use a screwdriver to open a gap
between the roof panel and the remainder of the plastic windshield stopper.
Opening Gap
Roof Panel
4. Test drive vehicle prior to reassembly to confirm that the noise has been eliminated.
5. Reassemble the vehicle.
Lower Windshield Retainers:
1. Carefully remove the plastic cowl cover at the base of the windshield and store it in a
safe location for reinstallation later (refer to the appropriate model year Repair Manual
for the proper procedure).
Page 5 of 6
UPPER/LOWER WINDSHIELD TICK NOISE – NV009-06
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
September 18, 2006
2. Locate the lower windshield retainers.
The retainers are typically located 140 – 200 mm (5.5 – 7.9 in.) inboard of the lower
corners of the windshield. The flat portion of the retainer is adhered to the backside of
the windshield with double-sided, foam-backed tape.
Pin is Attached
to Plastic Block
Underneath
Windshield
3. Use a “Mini” Hacksaw with a fine tooth 10-inch blade to cut OFF the pin portion of the
glass retainer flush with the flat portion of the windshield retainer (diagram below
shows the windshield retainer location to cut off the plastic pin).
View From Underneath Windshield
4. Test drive the vehicle to confirm the elimination of the noise.
5. Reassemble the vehicle.
Page 6 of 6
Technical Service
BULLETIN
January 3, 2007
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
REFINISHING REPLACEMENT
BUMPER COVERS
Models:
All ’06 – ’07 Toyota & Scion
In cases where a bumper cover is being replaced, a special preparation process is
necessary to assure the refinish is customer acceptable. This bulletin provides the
recommended refinishing procedure for new bumper covers.
S 2006 – 2007 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
Required
Tools &
Material
TOOLS & MATERIALS
RECOMMENDED PRODUCT
QUANTITY
Mild Soap — Ph neutral
(no wax type)
3Mt Car Shampoo
(or equivalent)
As Needed
Sanding Pad
3Mt ScotchBrite (Gray) 37448
Sanding Paste
Wax, Grease, & Silicone Remover
Plastic Part Adhesion Promoter
See Paint Manufacturer’s Recommendations
Primer and Paint
NOTE:
Please visit www.3m.com/automotive to find the nearest store that sells 3M
automotive products.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PAINT
PA001-07
Title:
REFINISHING REPLACEMENT BUMPER COVERS – PA001-07
Refinishing
Procedure
January 3, 2007
1. Mix a solution of mild soap (car wash soap with no wax additives) and clean water.
NOTE:
Carefully follow mixing instructions on the soap container. Too much soap or too
much water may cause surface contamination or rinsing difficulty.
2. Scrub the bumper covers with the soap and water solution, making sure all
difficult-to-reach areas are thoroughly cleaned.
3. Rinse the entire bumper cover with clean deionized water, making sure all
difficult-to-reach areas are thoroughly rinsed.
4. Dry the surface with a clean towel before water dries on the surface.
Clean, dry compressed air from an oil-less compressor may be substituted for drying
with a towel.
5. Degrease the surface with a wax, grease, and silicone remover.
NOTE:
Lacquer thinner or brake cleaner will NOT remove silicone. You MUST use a wax,
grease, and silicone remover. Carefully follow the application instructions on the
container label. Fish eyes or other paint irregularities may result from NOT following
the instructions.
6. Apply a generous amount of sanding paste with a gray 3Mt ScotchBrite pad.
Only a gray pad should be used during the sanding process. Sand the entire bumper
cover surface. Be sure all difficult-to-reach areas are thoroughly sanded.
7. Clean the entire bumper cover with car wash soap and water.
Be sure all difficult-to-reach areas are thoroughly cleaned.
8. Rinse the entire bumper with clean deionized water.
Be sure all difficult-to-reach areas are thoroughly rinsed.
9. Degrease the surface with an anti-static plastic parts cleaner and a white body
shop towel or paper towel.
NOTE:
NEVER use a red shop towel to wipe the surface (contains silicone).
10. Ensure the bumper is firmly held in place to a steady fixture.
11. Apply a plastic parts adhesion promoter to the surface, according to the
manufacturer ’s recommendations.
12. Apply plastic parts primer to the surface, according to the paint manufacturer’s
recommendations.
13. Since bumpers are made of flexible plastic urethane material, use a two-part urethane
finish paint system with plasticizer (flex agent) for all bumper and cladding repairs.
Apply the appropriate top coat to the surface, according to the paint manufacturer’s
recommendations.
Page 2 of 3
REFINISHING REPLACEMENT BUMPER COVERS – PA001-07
Refinishing
Procedure
(Continued)
January 3, 2007
14. If heat is applied to cure the paint, ensure the surface temperature does NOT exceed
176_F (80_C).
For additional information concerning the refinish process for plastic
bumpers/cladding, please contact your respective refinish paint manufacturer’s
local representative.
Wash with
Soap & Water
Rinse &
Towel Dry
Degrease
Step 1
Scrub with
Sanding
Paste
Wash with
Soap & Water
Rinse &
Towel Dry
Degrease
Step 2
Apply
Adhesion
Promoter
Apply
Primer
Apply Top
Coat
Page 3 of 3
PAINT STAINS UNDER RAPGARD
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’07 Toyota & Scion
November 20, 2006
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S March 2, 2007: The T1 code in the Warranty Information table has been updated.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
On some vehicles, when Rapgard is removed, the paint may have a stained
appearance. These stains appear to be under the clear coat and should not be
considered a defect in the paint (clear coat or color coat). The stain patterns are usually
under wrinkles in the Rapgard. These wrinkles sometimes trap water and cause the
paint to stain from the trapped moisture, especially on horizontal surfaces, such as the
hood, roof, and trunk. Stains can be removed by heating the stained surface to remove
the trapped moisture.
Stains
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2007 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
BD6004
Remove Paint Stain Under Rapgard
0.6
53301–#####
T1
T2
99 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PAINT
PA002-06
Title:
PAINT STAINS UNDER RAPGARD – PA002-06 Revised
Required
Tools &
Material
Repair
Procedure
November 20, 2006
TOOLS & MATERIALS
QUANTITY
Infrared Lamp or Heat Gun
1
Aluminum Foil or Damp Cloth
1
Thermometer
1
1. Use the aluminum foil or damp cloth to cover plastic/rubber parts that are near
the stain.
2. Apply heat to the stain using an infrared lamp or heat gun.
NOTE:
Apply heat for 5 – 10 minutes at 158_F – 176_F (70_C – 80_C). Do NOT allow the surface
to become hotter than 176_F (80_C). Measure the temperature with a thermometer.
3. After applying heat for 5 minutes, examine the area to determine if the stain has been
removed. If the stain still exists, continue to apply heat and re-examine the stain
5 minutes later.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
November 16, 2004
IRON PARTICLE RUST
CONTAMINATION REPAIR
Models:
’94 – Current Toyota & ’04 – Current Scion
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S December 16, 2004: Text has been revised to more accurately describe cleaner
(Auto MagicR Special Cleaner Concentratet is not an oxalic acid solution);
Applicable Vehicles has been defined more clearly.
The previous TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Condition
Inspection
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide information regarding the proper procedures to
clean vehicles that may have been subjected to contamination by airborne iron particles
such as rail dust.
S 1994 – Current model year Toyota vehicles.
S 2004 – Current model year Scion vehicles.
During rail transportation or extended storage near industrial areas, vehicles may
occasionally be subjected to contamination by airborne iron particles shed from railroad
tracks, train wheels, exposure to heavy machinery facilities, grinding, welding, etc.
This type of contamination can be identified by the presence of small red or brown
particles on the paint surface. These particles are often difficult to see on dark color
paints, but can be easily felt when brushing a hand across horizontal body surfaces such
as hood, roof, or deck lid.
CAUTION:
Because of the abrasiveness of these small iron particles, polishing or buffing
procedures should not be attempted to repair the paint surface of an affected vehicle.
This will result in further paint damage and detract from vehicle appearance.
Repair
Warranty
Information
Washing the affected paint surfaces with Auto MagicR Special Cleaner Concentratet
is the recommended method to dislodge embedded iron particles and remove the
surrounding rust stains. The correct usage of Auto MagicR Special Cleaner
Concentratet is described in this bulletin.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PAINT
PA005-04
Title:
IRON PARTICLE RUST CONTAMINATION REPAIR – PA005-04 Revised
Required
Tools &
Materials
TOOLS & MATERIALS
November 16, 2004
QUANTITY
Auto MagicR Special Cleaner Concentratet #713*
1
Rubber Gloves, Aprons, Boots
Eye Protection
Sponges or Wash Mitts
As Needed
Pail or Bucket
*
General
Precautions
Contact the main office of Auto Wax Company Inc. (1–800–826–0828 or www.automagic.biz) to find a
local source for Auto MagicR Special Cleaner Concentrate.t
WARNING:
Auto MagicR Special Cleaner Concentratet is a corrosive material. Appropriate
personal protection equipment must be worn to protect persons performing the
contamination removal procedure. Please refer to the precautions on the product
prior to use.
CAUTION:
Consult local or state regulations regarding the handling, use, and disposal of Auto
MagicR Special Cleaner Concentratet prior to use.
Under no circumstances should contamination removal be performed in direct
sunlight or contamination removal solution be allowed to dry on vehicle surfaces, as
staining of plastic, rubber, or painted parts may result.
Repair
Procedure
1. Move vehicle out of direct sunlight. Initially rinse with cool water then wash with liquid
car wash detergent. Rinse again thoroughly with fresh water.
2. Dilute the mixture to a 1:8 ratio for painted surfaces. Use the recommended dilution
ratio when applying to any other surface. Apply the diluted cleaner so that it evenly
covers the affected area. Use an appropriate mitt or sponge to agitate the surface.
3. Thoroughly rinse vehicle with fresh water.
4. Inspect vehicle carefully both visually and by feel to determine if all iron particles have
been removed. Repeat the wash several times if necessary to achieve complete
removal.
5. Dry vehicle with a soft terry cloth towel and apply a non–abrasive, non–silicone glaze
to obtain a high–gloss finish.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 30, 2007
Introduction
POWER SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
DURING PDS
Models:
’07 Applicable Toyota
The following is a list of the vehicle systems (Power Window, Sliding Roof, Tire
Pressure Warning System [TPWS], etc.) that need initialization during Pre-Delivery
Service (PDS) and the TSB numbers containing details on initializing each
specific system.
NOTE:
Items in RED also need to be initialized any time the battery has been disconnected.
Applicable
Vehicles
Power
System
Initialization
Table
S 2007 model year Applicable Toyota vehicles listed in the following table.
INITIALIZATION SYSTEM ITEMS
MODEL NAME
4Runner
Warranty
Information
BACK DOOR
POWER
WINDOW
COMPASS
POWER
WINDOW
POWER
BACK
DOOR
POWER
SLIDING
DOOR
SLIDING
ROOF
DIRECT TPWS
PD082Ć06
PD089Ć06
PD083Ć06
-
-
PD083Ć06
PD085Ć06
Avalon
-
PD058Ć06
PD057Ć06
-
-
PD055Ć06
PD069Ć06
Camry
-
PD006Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD007Ć06
Camry HV
-
PD016Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD019Ć06
Corolla
-
PD041Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD043Ć06
FJ Cruiser
-
PD093Ć05
-
-
-
-
-
Highlander
-
PD088Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD073Ć06
Highlander HV
-
PD087Ć06
-
-
-
-
-
Land Cruiser
-
PD063Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD074Ć06
Matrix
-
PD053Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD060Ć06
Prius
-
-
PG003Ć06
-
-
-
PD100Ć06
RAV4
-
-
-
-
-
-
PD086Ć06
Sequoia
PD050Ć06
PD051Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD068Ć06
Sienna
-
PD118Ć06
PD116Ć06
PD115Ć06
PD114Ć06
PD117Ć06
PD119Ć06
Solara
-
PD035Ć06
PD030Ć06
-
-
PD029Ć06
PD034Ć06
Tacoma
-
PD105Ć06
-
-
-
-
PD075Ć06
Tundra
-
PD004Ć07
-
-
-
-
PD005Ć07
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD010-07
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
July 16, 2004
Introduction
WHEEL FILM FOR BRAKE ROTOR
RUST PREVENTION
Models:
All Models with Wheel Film
To prevent brake rotor rust from forming during transportation and storage, wheel film will
be adopted instead of using a cardboard type anti–rust cover.
The purpose of the wheel film is to protect the disc brake rotor from weather elements
and initial rust before the vehicle is delivered to the customer. Consequently, the film
should remain on the wheel as long as possible.
NOTE:
S Retain the wheel film on the disc wheel during vehicle display and storage.
S Do not remove the wheel film right away at Pre–Delivery Service (PDS) if the vehicle
will be stored after PDS.
S Remove the wheel film just prior to delivery to customers.
Features of Wheel Film:
Material: Polyethylene
Color: Transparent
Wheel Film
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All Models with wheel film.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE–DELIVERY SERVICE
PD017-04
Title:
WHEEL FILM FOR BRAKE ROTOR RUST PREVENTION – PD017-04
Removal
Procedure
July 16, 2004
Firmly hold the outer end of the wheel film to pull it off.
NOTE:
S If film adhesive residue is found on the disc wheel, remove it with a soft
cloth dipped in ethyl alcohol (ethanol). Do not use thinner to remove the
adhesive residue.
S When the wheel film is removed below an ambient temperature of 0_C (32_F), it is
possible that the film may tear. For ease of film removal in cold conditions, please
warm the film above 0_C (32_F) using one of the following methods:
– Splash (hot) water on the wheel film.
– Warm wheel film with cotton cloth soaked in hot water.
– Warm wheel film with heat gun. Be sure not to overheat the film and wheel.
– Warm wheel film by infrared heater (lamp) for paint. Be sure not to overheat
the film and wheel.
– Warm wheel film by steam car wash.
– Park vehicle indoors (e.g. garage, etc.) for an extended period of time.
Disposal
Procedure
Page 2 of 3
Please follow local laws for disposal. Polyethylene film will not generate harmful gasses
when it is burned.
WHEEL FILM FOR BRAKE ROTOR RUST PREVENTION – PD017-04
Introduction
Schedule
MODEL
(FRONT &
REAR)
July 16, 2004
2003
2004
PLANT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Avalon
TMMK
Camry
Celica
JAPAN
NUMMI
TMMC
Front
Rear
Corolla
Front
Rear
JAPAN
Highlander
Matrix
TMMC
Front
Rear
MR2
Prius
JAPAN
RAV4
Solara
TMMK
Scion xA
Scion xB
JAPAN
Scion tC
This is a tentative schedule. There is a possibility that the introduction timing may be delayed on some models.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 21, 2007
Introduction
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY
SERVICE (PDS)
Models:
’08 4Runner
Pre-Delivery Service is a critical step in satisfying your dealership’s new car customers.
Customer feedback indicates the following areas deserve special attention when
performing PDS:
S Careful inspection for paint chips/scratches and body dents/dings.
S Proper operation of electrical accessories (including interior light, clock, and
radio reset).
S Interior cleanliness.
S Proper function of mechanical systems.
Customer retention and proper maintenance of vehicles has been a major focus for
Toyota. To help remind customers that regular oil changes are essential to the proper
maintenance of their vehicle, dealers are required to begin installing a first oil change
reminder sticker prior to delivery. By doing this, customers will be reminded to return to
your dealership for their first oil change. Your current oil change reminder sticker may
be used. (See PDS Check Sheet item G09.)
A new PDS form has been developed for the 2008 model year 4Runner. Some check
points have been added, expanded, or clarified. TSBs are available for items in bold
red type.
Warranty
Policy
If the need for additional repairs or adjustment is noted during the Pre-Delivery Service,
the required service should be performed under warranty. Reimbursement will be
managed under the warranty policy.
The Warranty Policy and Procedures Manual requires that you maintain the
completed PDS check sheet in the customer’s file. If you cannot produce a completed
form for each retailed vehicle upon TMS and/or Region/Distributor audit, the PDS
payment amount will be subject to debit.
An additional Repair Order completed in conjunction with normal PDS must have time
punch/flags for service. If multiple repairs are performed, separate time flags must be
punched for each repair.
Reimbursement
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
001013
Pre-Delivery Service (PDS)
0.9
N/A
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
T1
T2
N/A N/A
Page 1 of 5
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD069-07
Title:
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
2008 Model
Year PDS
Check Sheet
Page 2 of 5
June 21, 2007
TOYOTA 4RUNNER
2008 PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE CHECK SHEET
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
June 21, 2007
Before
Inspection
When performing new car Pre-Delivery Service, install Short Pin before moving vehicle
from storage lot so that FUNCTIONAL OPERATION checks can begin as soon as vehicle
is moved into the service stall.
A01 Install Short Pin
A02 Initialize driver’s door power window
A03 Initialize moon roof*
A04 Initialize back door power window
Functional
Operation
Apply parking brake and turn ignition “ON,” place gear selector in reverse, turn on
lights and rear defogger. Unlock all doors, release fuel door, release back door.
B01 Check dome, courtesy, map, and sun visor lights*
B02 Check warning/indicator lights, gauges, and horn
B03 Check windshield wipers and washers
B04 Check headlights, instrument lights, turn signals, emergency flashers, and
brake lights
B05 Check inside/outside rear view mirror operation/adjustment
B06 Check cigarette lighter* and power outlets
Check the power outlets using an electrical accessory designed for this use.
B07 Check moon roof*
B08 Check audio/navigation*/backup camera* system and set clock*
For navigation, set the destination search area to local position.
B09 Check Rear Seat Entertainment System operation*
B10 Install shift-lock override button cover
Walkaround
Inspection
Starting at the left front door, check window and door lock operation and the operation
of all power windows and door locks from master power switch, on vehicles so equipped.
While walking around vehicle in a counterclockwise direction, open left rear door and
check operation of window regulator and door lock, set child safety door locks to the
normal (unlocked) position. Assure tightness of interior garnishes and check seat belts.
Inspect luggage compartment contents and lights at rear of vehicle. Repeat checks at
right rear door. Inspect right front door window regulator and lock operation and
garnishes. Check seat and seat belt operation. Continue on around to the front of the
vehicle checking lights.
C01 Check window operation
C02 Check door and door lock operation, including wireless remote control/theft
deterrent system*
C03 Check that engine starts with all keys
C04 Check that child safety door locks are in normal (unlocked) position
C05 Check seats and seat belt operation
C06 Check rear defogger
C07 Check side marker, tail, backup, and license plate lights
C08 Check luggage compartment light* and trim appearance
C09 Adjust spare tire pressure and check jack and tool installation
C10 Check headlight aim
Refer to the Repair Manual for procedures.
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
Page 3 of 5
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
Under Hood
June 21, 2007
D01 Check engine oil and ATM fluid levels
D02 Check brake and power steering fluid levels
Visually inspect using see-through reservoirs.
D03 Check engine coolant level
D04 Check battery state-of-charge using Digital Battery System Analyzer
Refer to TSB No. PG001-06, “Battery Maintenance for In-Stock Vehicles
& Pre-Delivery.”
NOTE:
Battery SOC should be a minimum of 75%. Please enter the SOC Reading on the space
provided on the check sheet and attach the printout to the check sheet.
D05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks
Under Vehicle
(On Hoist)
E01 Remove disc brake anti-rust covers/anti-corrosion wheel film
Visually inspect rotors for rust.
NOTE:
For best rotor rust prevention, retain wheel film on vehicle until just prior to
customer delivery.
E02 Inspect tires for defects/damage and adjust tire pressure
(including spare tire)
The recommended tire inflation pressure changes with tire size, driving conditions,
and vehicle model. For precise tire pressure information, refer to the Owner’s
Manual and/or tire information label located on the vehicle.
Sidewall “Maximum” cold tire inflation pressure should not be used for
normal driving.
E03 Activate tire pressure monitor
E04 Install wheel covers/caps/spare tire wheel covers*
E05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks
Road Test
Page 4 of 5
A complete road test helps assure customer satisfaction. Drive vehicle over a variety of
road surfaces and driving conditions. Check for unusual noises and driving performance.
F01 Check cold engine operation
Check starting and fast idle operation performance.
F02 Check engine operation during warm-up
Check that engine operates smoothly during warm-up.
Check for unusual noise, engine vibration, rough idle, etc.
F03 Check engine at normal operating temperature
Check engine performance over a broad range of driving conditions, including idle
quality, acceleration, cruise, and deceleration.
F04 Check automatic transmission operation
Check automatic transmission operation, including operation in each range, neutral
start switch, and shift lock system.
F05 Check brake and parking brake operation
Check brake function, including unusual noise, parking brake performance, and all
related brake system indicator lights.
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
June 21, 2007
Road Test
(Continued)
F06 Check steering operation and off-center/vehicle pull/flutter
Check steering function.
Check steering off-center/vehicle pull/flutter.
F07 Inspect for abnormal noises and vibration
F08 Inspect for squeaks and rattles
F09 Check heater and A/C operation
F10 Check cruise control operation
Check cruise control, including On-Off switch, “SET/COAST,” “RESUME/ACCEL,”
and “CANCEL” functions.
F11 Check front seat heater operation*
F12 Set/calibrate compass*
F13 Check Rear Height Control Air Suspension*
Final
Inspection
& Cleaning
G01 Remove interior protective covers, unnecessary labels, tags, etc.
(Remove protective covers just before delivery to the customer)
Remove plastic covers from door panels, seats, head restraints, and sun visors,
as required.
Remove labels, tags, and stickers (except those containing owner information).
NOTE:
Consumer information labels, such as airbag information warning and bumper
information labels, MUST be left on the vehicle until delivery to a retail customer.
G02
G03
G04
G05
G06
G07
G08
G09
Visually inspect all interior parts for installation, damage, fit, dirt, etc.
Remove Rapgard TM protective film
Wash and clean vehicle
Inspect paint finish for scratches, chips, rust, dents, damage, etc.
Install roof rack cross bars
Install receiver towing hitch cap
Inspect exterior body parts for proper installation, damage, rust, etc.
Place oil change sticker on inside of windshield, top left corner
Complete the mileage or date recommendation and apply the oil change reminder
sticker to the inside of the windshield, top left corner. You may use your current oil
change reminder sticker or order new stickers by calling 1–800–527–6283.
G10 Install front and rear license plates
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
Page 5 of 5
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 10, 2006
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Installation
Procedure
FRONT & REAR LICENSE PLATE
INSTALLATION DURING PDS
Models:
’07 4Runner
The following procedure is recommended for front and rear license plate installation on
2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Front License Plate
1. Align the holes on the license plate to
the dimples on the front bumper.
2. Install two (2) self-tapping screws
through the license plate and into the
front bumper at the dimples.
NOTE:
S Do NOT drill holes into the bumper.
S Do NOT overtighten the screws.
Dimples
Use self-tapping screws of a
non-corroding type with the
following dimensions:
Nominal Length: 16.5 mm (0.65 in.) –
20.0 mm (0.79 in.)
6.0 mm
(0.24 in.)
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.24 in.)
16.5 – 20.0 mm
(0.65 – 0.79 in.)
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD079-06
Title:
FRONT & REAR LICENSE PLATE INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD079-06
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
August 10, 2006
Rear License Plate
1. Align the installation holes on the rear license plate with the holes on the back door.
2. Install two (2) bolts through the license plate and into the holes (welded nuts) in the
back door.
Use bolts of a non–corroding type having the following dimensions:
Nominal Length: 25.0 mm (0.98 in.) or shorter
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.24 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.04 in.)
NOTE:
If bolts longer than 25 mm (0.98 in.) are used, the back door window glass may be
damaged or broken.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 10, 2006
Introduction
ROOF RACK CROSS BAR
INSTALLATION DURING PDS
Models:
’07 4Runner
To prevent paint damage during transportation, the roof rack cross bars are kept inside
the vehicle so that the Rapgardt protective film can remain in place on the roof panel.
Install the roof rack cross bars to the roof rack rails according to the following procedure
during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS).
NOTE:
To prevent damage to the front and rear roof rack leg covers, install the cross bar
stoppers at each end of the right and left roof rack rails.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Installation
Procedure
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
1. Loosen the adjustment knobs on each
cross bar joint.
NOTE:
Do NOT remove adjustment
knobs completely.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD080-06
Title:
ROOF RACK CROSS BAR INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD080-06
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
August 10, 2006
2. Slide the cross bar ends into the
grooves of the right and left roof rack
rails with the arrow on each cross bar
facing forward.
Front
NOTE:
The cross bars will create wind noise
at highway speeds if they are
installed backwards.
Arrow Mark
3. Align the ends of the front and rear
cross bars with the paint marks on the
roof rack as illustrated. Then securely
tighten the knobs.
Front
Paint Mark
NOTE:
Installation positions of cross bars
shown above are most effective to
reduce wind noise.
4. Install the right and left rear roof rack
leg covers.
A
A. Insert the protrusion at the front of
the cover into the roof rack rail.
B. Place the cover on the leg,
aligning each rear end.
At this time, do NOT press
the cover down.
C. Engage the cover claws located
towards the outside of the vehicle.
D. Engage the cover claws located
towards the inside of the vehicle.
NOTE:
If the inside and outside cover claws
are pressed down at the same time, the
cover claws may be damaged.
E. Check that the cover is
installed securely.
Page 2 of 3
D
Outside
Rear
C
B
ROOF RACK CROSS BAR INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD080-06
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
5. Install the cross bar stopper at the
front and rear ends of the right and
left roof rack rail.
August 10, 2006
Front
NOTE:
Cross bar stoppers are installed to
prevent damage caused by
interference between the cross bar and
the front and rear roof rack leg covers.
Cross Bar Stopper
Rear
Cross Bar Stopper
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 15, 2006
SHORT PIN INSTALLATION
DURING PDS
Models:
’07 4Runner
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S October 27, 2006: The “Introduction” section has been updated, and the
“DTC Clearing Procedure” section has been added.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
SSTs
To minimize battery discharge during transportation and storage, the Short Pin has been
removed at the assembly plant and temporarily stored in the engine compartment Relay
Block. Reinstall the Short Pin into its original location and confirm all related DTCs are
cleared during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS).
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
ITEM
NO.
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
TOY220036
1
9
01002744
1
9
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
1
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
S 12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
(P/N 01002593–005) with version 13.4a Software
(or later) is required.
CAN Interface Module Kit*
2
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
* Essential SSTs.
** Drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, CAN Interface Modules, Program Cards, or other
SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD081-06
Title:
SHORT PIN INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD081-06 Revised
Installation
Procedure
The Short Pin is stored in the blank space
of the Relay Block in the engine
compartment.
August 15, 2006
Engine Compartment
Relay Block
During Pre-Delivery Service (PDS),
install the Short Pin in the Relay Block
as shown.
NOTE:
S Removing the Short Pin cuts off
power sources relating to the
DOME, RADIO No. 1, and
ECU-B fuses.
S The Short Pin does not function as
a fuse, so install it only in the
position shown.
S If the vehicle is stored in the
dealership for a long period of
time after PDS, disconnect the
negative (–) battery terminal to
prevent battery discharge. Refer to
TSB No. PG001-06, “Battery
Maintenance for In-Stock Vehicles &
Pre-Delivery,” for battery
maintenance information.
Page 2 of 3
Relay Block
Install Short Pin Here
(Original Location)
Remove This
Short Pin
SHORT PIN INSTALLTION DURING PDS – PD081-06 Revised
DTC Clearing
Procedure
August 15, 2006
With the Short Pin removed, the occupant classification ECU and Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly (airbag ECU) may detect the interruption in battery voltage (B+) and store a
DTC. Clear DTC B1150 and B1794 after installing the Short Pin.
1. Connect the Diagnostic Tester to
the DLC3.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the
“IG-ON” position.
3. Using the Diagnostic Tester, check
any other codes being output.
HINT:
If any DTCs besides DTC B1150
and B1794 remain, repair the
applicable system according to
the Repair Manual.
DLC3
Diagnostic Tester
4. Erase DTC (B1150 and B1794) and
Freeze Frame Data.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 15, 2006
Introduction
INITIALIZATION OF BACK DOOR
POWER WINDOW DURING PDS
Models:
’07 4Runner
This bulletin outlines the initialization procedure for the back door power window on
the 4Runner.
To minimize the battery discharge during transportation and storage, the Short Pin has
been removed at the assembly plant, resulting in the following feature being inoperative:
S One-touch open and close with jam protection.
Use the following initialization procedure after installing the Short Pin during Pre-Delivery
Service (PDS) and whenever the battery has been disconnected.
NOTE:
Any time the battery terminal has been disconnected, the back door power window
MUST be re-initialized.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Initialization
Procedure
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Make sure the Short Pin is installed
in its original location. (Refer to TSB
No. PD081-06, “Short Pin Installation
During PDS.”)
Short Pin Original Location
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD082-06
Title:
INITIALIZATION OF BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW DURING PDS – PD082-06
Initialization
Procedure
(Continued)
August 15, 2006
1. Turn ignition switch to the
“ON” position.
2. Push the back door power window
switch to the “DOWN” side to open
the window.
3. Push and hold the back door power
window switch to the “UP” side until
the window closes. Continue holding it
for approximately 1 second.
4. Check for proper operation of the
“one-touch open/close” functions by
pushing the switch briefly to the
“DOWN” and “UP” positions.
NOTE:
Jam protection function becomes
effective through the above
initialization procedure.
Page 2 of 2
Completely Closed
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 15, 2006
Introduction
DRIVER'S DOOR POWER WINDOW &
MOON ROOF INITIALIZATION
Models:
’07 4Runner
This bulletin outlines the initialization procedure for the driver’s door power window and
the moon roof on 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
If the battery has been disconnected, the ECU will not be able to detect and memorize
the driver’s door power window and moon roof positions, resulting in the following
features being inoperative:
S One-touch open and close of driver’s door power window with jam protection.
S One-touch slide open and close of moon roof with jam protection.
S One-touch tilt up and down of moon roof with jam protection.
Use the following initialization procedure during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS) and
whenever the battery has been disconnected.
NOTE:
Any time the battery terminal has been disconnected, the driver’s door power window
and moon roof MUST be re-initialized.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Initialization
Procedure
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Driver’s Door Power Window
1. Turn the ignition to the “ON” position.
NOTE:
At this time, the power switch for
the driver’s door window should
be blinking.
2. Push down and hold the driver’s door
power window switch to completely
open the window.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Power Window Switch
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD083-06
Title:
DRIVER’S DOOR POWER WINDOW & MOON ROOF INITIALIZATION – PD083-06
Initialization
Procedure
(Continued)
3. Pull and hold up the driver’s door
power window switch until the window
closes. Continue holding the switch
for approximately one second until the
switch changes from blinking to a
constant illumination.
August 15, 2006
Completely Closed
4. Check for proper operation of the
“one-touch open/close” by pushing
the switch briefly to the “DOWN” and
“UP” positions.
NOTE:
Jam protection function becomes
effective through the above
initialization procedure.
TROUBLESHOOTING:
If power window is unable to close after initialization, perform the
following procedure.
NOTE:
If the power window switch is continuously operated for a long time, the power
window motor will stop to prevent additional load on the motor. Continuing to press
the power window switch even after the motor has stopped will cause the switch to
blink and will restrict the AUTO UP/DOWN function and remote UP/DOWN function.
If this happens, wait for a few minutes before attempting to reset the motor again.
1. Disconnect the negative (–) battery terminal. After 10 seconds, reconnect the
battery terminal.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. Halfway close the door glass by
pressing the switch. Then fully pull up on the switch until the door glass is fully
closed, and continue holding the switch for approximately one second after the
door glass is fully closed.
" Check for proper operation of the AUTO UP/DOWN function.
3. If the power window motor is still unable to close:
Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. Halfway close the door glass by
pressing the switch. Then fully pull up on the switch until the door glass is fully
closed, and continue holding the switch for approximately 12 seconds after the
door glass is fully closed.
" Check for proper operation of the AUTO UP/DOWN function.
Page 2 of 3
DRIVER’S DOOR POWER WINDOW & MOON ROOF INITIALIZATION – PD083-06
Initialization
Procedure
(Continued)
August 15, 2006
Moon Roof
1. Turn the ignition to the “ON” position.
2. Push and hold the “TILT UP” side of the
switch until the moon roof tilts all the way
up and then tilts down slightly
(approximately 10 mm [0.39 in.] at
the rear).
3. Check for proper operation of the
“one-touch slide open/close” and
“one-touch tilt up/down” functions
by pushing the switch briefly to
the “SLIDE OPEN” and
“TILT UP” positions.
Approx. 10 mm
NOTE:
Jam protection function becomes
effective through the above
initialization procedure.
Page 3 of 3
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
VALVE/SENSOR ACTIVATION
Models:
’07 4Runner
August 16, 2006
Introduction
The 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles are equipped with a direct-type Tire Pressure
Warning System (TPWS). Each tire (including the spare tire) has a tire pressure warning
valve/sensor, and the measured tire pressure data is transmitted to the Tire Pressure
Warning System antenna/receiver to the Tire Pressure Warning System ECU.
During Pre-Delivery Service (PDS), the tire pressure warning valves/sensors must be
activated according to the procedure in this bulletin.
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
SSTs
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
ITEM
NO.
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
TOY220036
1
9
01002744
1
9
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
S 12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
(P/N 01002593–005) with version 13.4a Software
(or later) is required.
1
CAN Interface Module Kit*
2
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
* Essential SSTs.
** Refers to drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, CAN Interface Modules, Program Cards, or other
SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
PD085-06
Title:
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE/SENSOR ACTIVATION – PD085-06
Reference
August 16, 2006
S The Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
will blink until all the tire pressure
warning valves/sensors are activated.
S The Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
listed below may be stored in the
TPWS ECU until the tire pressure
warning valves/sensors are activated.
S The DTCs will automatically clear
when the tire pressure warning
valves/sensors are activated.
*1:
*2:
Activation
Procedure
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
DTC NO. *1
DTC NO. *2
DTC EXPLANATION
11
C2111
Transmitter ID1 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
12
C2112
Transmitter ID2 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
13
C2113
Transmitter ID3 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
14
C2114
Transmitter ID4 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
15
C2115
Transmitter ID5 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
DTC No. indicated by blinking of the Low Tire Pressure Warning Light.
DTC No. indicated on the Toyota Diagnostic Tester.
1. Connect the Diagnostic Tester.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON”
position and check that the Low Tire
Pressure Warning Light blinks.
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Page 2 of 3
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE/SENSOR ACTIVATION – PD085-06
Activation
Procedure
(Continued)
3. Press or remove the valve core to
reduce the tire inflation pressure
rapidly by 6 psi (0.4 kgf/cm2, 40 kPa),
or more, within 30 seconds.
August 16, 2006
Core
If the tire inflation pressure is NOT
reduced by 6 psi (0.4 kgf/cm2,
40 kPa), or more, within 30 seconds,
the tire pressure warning
valves/sensors will NOT be activated.
NOTE:
This operation is required for the
system to be activated and must be
performed for each tire (including the
spare tire), one at a time.
4. Using the Diagnostic Tester, check for TPWS DTCs.
S If NO DTCs are stored, go to step 5.
S If DTCs C2111 – C2115 are stored, repeat step 3.
S If any other DTCs are stored, refer to the Repair Manual.
5. Adjust all tires (including the spare tire) to the standard tire inflation pressure and
confirm that the Low Tire Pressure Warning Light is OFF.
TIRE SIZE
P265/70R16 111S
P265/65R17 110S
TIRE PRESSURE (psi, kgf/cm2, kPa)
32 2.2,
32,
2 2 220
NOTE:
S If there is great difference between the current temperature of the tire and wheel
(for example: shop temperature) and expected temperature (for example: outdoor
temperature), this needs to be considered when adjusting the tire pressure.
S Adjust the tire pressure when the tires are cold.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 16, 2006
Introduction
INITIAL CALIBRATION OF COMPASS
DURING PDS
Models:
’07 4Runner
The compass indicates the direction that the vehicle is heading by detecting the
direction and strength of the Earth’s magnetic field and processing this data using
the compass sensor and microcomputer.
Detection of the direction and strength of the Earth’s magnetic field varies according to
the area in which the vehicle is used and is affected by the residual magnetism of the
vehicle. For this reason, the geographic direction displayed may also deviate from the
direction determined by the Earth’s magnetic field according to the area in which the
vehicle is used.
Perform the initial calibration of the compass at the dealership prior to vehicle delivery.
Compass Display
“Multifunction” Switch
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD089-06
Title:
INITIAL CALIBRATION OF COMPASS DURING PDS – PD089-06
Compass
Calibration
Procedure
August 16, 2006
1. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON”
position and push and hold the switch
for 6 seconds until the zone number
appears on the compass display.
2. Push the switch to select the
number of the zone where the
vehicle is located.
See the map below for
zone reference.
A. Samoa:
Guam:
Saipan:
North America
1
15
2
14
3
13
4
12
5
8
6
7
Page 2 of 3
9
10
11
5
7
7
INITIAL CALIBRATION OF COMPASS DURING PDS – PD089-06
Compass
Calibration
Procedure
(Continued)
August 16, 2006
3. Start the engine and push and hold
the switch for about 9 seconds until
“C” appears on the display.
4. Drive the vehicle slowly at 5 mph
(8 km/h), or less, in a circle until the
direction is displayed. If there is NOT
enough space to drive in a circle, turn
the car around as shown, doing two
three-point turns in succession.
After driving in 1 to 3 circles in the
above method, calibration is complete
with the direction shown on
the display.
NOTE:
S Do NOT perform calibration of the
compass in a place where the
Earth’s magnetic field is subject to
interference by artificial magnetic
fields (underground parking, under a
steel tower, between buildings, roof
parking, near a railroad crossing,
near a large vehicle, etc.)
S During calibration, do NOT operate
electric systems (moon roof, power
windows, etc.) as they may interfere
with the calibration.
Page 3 of 3
TOYOTA 4RUNNER
B. FUNCTIONAL OPERATION
Apply parking brake and turn ignition “ON,” place gear selector in reverse, turn on lights and
rear defogger. Unlock doors, release fuel door, release back door.
F. ROAD TEST
01 INSTALL SHORT PIN
.........
02 Initialize driver’s door power window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
03 Initialize moon roof* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
04 Initialize back door power window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
A complete road test helps assure customer satisfaction. Drive vehicle over
a variety of road surfaces and driving conditions. Check for unusual noise and
driving performance.
Check dome, courtesy, map, and sun visor lights*..
Check warning/indicator lights, gauges, and horn . .
Check windshield wipers and washers . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check headlights, instrument lights, turn signals,
emergency flashers, and brake lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check inside/outside rear view mirror
operation/adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check cigarette lighter* and power outlets . . . . . . . . .
Check moon roof* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check audio/navigation*/backup camera* system
and set clock* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check Rear Seat Entertainment System operation* .
Install shift-lock override button cover . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enter Odometer Reading
Reading Before Test
Reading After Test
01
02
03
04
05
06
C. WALKAROUND INSPECTION
Start at left front door. Check window and door lock operation (from master power
switch, if equipped). Continue around vehicle in a counterclockwise direction
checking each door and window operation, child door locks, seat belts, interior
condition, all lights, luggage compartment contents. Remove rubber body plugs
from glove box for installation during UNDER VEHICLE inspection. Finish by
checking headlight aim and continue into UNDER HOOD checks.
01 Check window operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
02 Check door and door lock operation, including
wireless remote control/theft deterrent system* . . . . . .
03 Check that engine starts with all keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
04 Check that child safety door locks are in normal
(unlocked) position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
05 Check seats and seat belt operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
06 Check rear defogger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
07 Check side marker, tail, backup, and
license plate lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
08 Check luggage compartment light* and
trim appearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
09 Adjust spare tire pressure and check jack and
tool installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10 Check headlight aim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
Check cold engine operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check engine operation during warm–up . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check engine at normal operating temperature . . . . . .
Check automatic transmission operation . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check brake and parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . . .
Check steering operation and off-center/
vehicle pull/flutter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inspect for abnormal noises and vibration . . . . . . . . . . .
Inspect for squeaks and rattles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check heater and A/C operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check cruise control operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check front seat heater operation* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Set/calibrate compass* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check Rear Height Control Air Suspension* . . . . . . . . .
G. FINAL INSPECTION AND CLEANING
01 Remove interior protective covers, unnecessary labels,
tags, etc. (Remove protective covers just before
delivery to the customer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
02 Visually inspect all interior parts for installation,
damage, fit, dirt, etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
03 Remove RapgardTM protective film . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
04 Wash and clean vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
05 Inspect paint finish for scratches, chips, rust,
dents, damage, etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
06 Install roof rack cross bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
07 Install receiver towing hitch cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
08 Inspect exterior body parts for proper installation,
damage, rust, etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
09 Place oil change sticker on inside of windshield,
top left corner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10 Install front and rear license plates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
D. UNDER HOOD
01
02
03
04
Check engine oil and ATM fluid levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check brake and power steering fluid levels . . . . . . . . . . .
Check engine coolant level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check battery state-of-charge using Digital Battery
System Analyzer (SOC Reading: ________%) . . . . . . . . . .
05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks . . . .
COMMENTS
Completion and retention of this form is required to comply with Toyota’s Warranty Policy.
TECHNICIAN’S SIGNATURE
SERVICE MANAGER’S SIGNATURE
NAME (PLEASE PRINT)
NAME (PLEASE PRINT)
Date
Dealer Name
OK
E. UNDER VEHICLE (ON HOIST)
01 Remove disc brake anti-rust covers/anti-corrosion
wheel film . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
02 Inspect tires for defects/damage and adjust
tire pressure (including spare tire) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
03 Activate tire pressure monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
04 Install wheel covers/caps/spare tire wheel covers* . . .
05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks . . . .
Adjust/
Repair
OK
A. BEFORE INSPECTION
Adjust/
Repair
2007 PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE CHECK SHEET
Dealer Code
* Inspect or Install when Equipped/Required
We hereby certify that all items
on this form have been checked and
corrected for proper operation
as required.
Vehicle Identification Number (Sticker)
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 16, 2006
Introduction
2007 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY
SERVICE (PDS)
Models:
’07 4Runner
Pre-Delivery Service is a critical step in satisfying your dealership’s new car customers.
Customer feedback indicates the following areas deserve special attention when
performing PDS:
S Careful inspection for paint chips/scratches and body dents/dings.
S Proper operation of electrical accessories (including interior light, clock, and
radio reset).
S Interior cleanliness.
S Proper function of mechanical systems.
Customer retention and proper maintenance of vehicles has been a major focus for
Toyota. To help remind customers that regular oil changes are essential to the proper
maintenance of their vehicle, dealers are required to begin installing a first oil change
reminder sticker prior to delivery. By doing this, customers will be reminded to return to
your dealership for their first oil change. Your current oil change reminder sticker may
be used. (See PDS Check Sheet item G09.)
A new PDS form has been developed for the 2007 model year 4Runner. Some check
points have been added, expanded, or clarified. TSBs are available for items in bold
red type.
Warranty
Policy
If the need for additional repairs or adjustment is noted during the Pre-Delivery Service,
the required service should be performed under warranty. Reimbursement will be
managed under the warranty policy.
The Warranty Policy and Procedures Manual requires that you maintain the
completed PDS check sheet in the customer’s file. If you cannot produce a completed
form for each retailed vehicle upon TMS and/or Region/Distributor audit, the PDS
payment amount will be subject to debit.
An additional Repair Order completed in conjunction with normal PDS must have time
punch/flags for service. If multiple repairs are performed, separate time flags must be
punched for each repair.
Reimbursement
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
001013
Pre-Delivery Service (PDS)
0.9
N/A
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
T1
T2
N/A N/A
Page 1 of 5
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD099-06
Title:
2007 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD099-06
2007 Model
Year PDS
Check Sheet
Page 2 of 5
August 16, 2006
TOYOTA 4RUNNER
2007 PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE CHECK SHEET
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
2007 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD099-06
August 16, 2006
Before
Inspection
When performing new car Pre-Delivery Service, install Short Pin before moving vehicle
from storage lot so that FUNCTIONAL OPERATION checks can begin as soon as vehicle
is moved into the service stall.
A01 Install Short Pin
A02 Initialize driver’s door power window
A03 Initialize moon roof*
A04 Initialize back door power window
Functional
Operation
Apply parking brake and turn ignition “ON,” place gear selector in reverse, turn on
lights and rear defogger. Unlock all doors, release fuel door, release back door.
B01 Check dome, courtesy, map, and sun visor lights*
B02 Check warning/indicator lights, gauges, and horn
B03 Check windshield wipers and washers
B04 Check headlights, instrument lights, turn signals, emergency flashers, and
brake lights
B05 Check inside/outside rear view mirror operation/adjustment
B06 Check cigarette lighter* and power outlets
Check the power outlets using an electrical accessory designed for this use.
B07 Check moon roof*
B08 Check audio/navigation*/backup camera* system and set clock*
For navigation, set the destination search area to local position.
B09 Check Rear Seat Entertainment System operation*
B10 Install shift-lock override button cover
Walkaround
Inspection
Starting at the left front door, check window and door lock operation and the operation
of all power windows and door locks from master power switch, on vehicles so equipped.
While walking around vehicle in a counterclockwise direction, open left rear door and
check operation of window regulator and door lock, set child safety door locks to the
normal (unlocked) position. Assure tightness of interior garnishes and check seat belts.
Inspect luggage compartment contents and lights at rear of vehicle. Repeat checks at
right rear door. Inspect right front door window regulator and lock operation and
garnishes. Check seat and seat belt operation. Continue on around to the front of the
vehicle checking lights.
C01 Check window operation
C02 Check door and door lock operation, including wireless remote control/theft
deterrent system*
C03 Check that engine starts with all keys
C04 Check that child safety door locks are in normal (unlocked) position
C05 Check seats and seat belt operation
C06 Check rear defogger
C07 Check side marker, tail, backup, and license plate lights
C08 Check luggage compartment light* and trim appearance
C09 Adjust spare tire pressure and check jack and tool installation
C10 Check headlight aim
Refer to the Repair Manual for procedures.
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
Page 3 of 5
2007 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD099-06
Under Hood
August 16, 2006
D01 Check engine oil and ATM fluid levels
D02 Check brake and power steering fluid levels
Visually inspect using see-through reservoirs.
D03 Check engine coolant level
D04 Check battery state-of-charge using Digital Battery System Analyzer
Refer to TSB No. PG001-06, “Battery Maintenance for In-Stock Vehicles
& Pre-Delivery.”
NOTE:
Battery SOC should be a minimum of 75%. Please enter the SOC Reading on the space
provided on the check sheet and attach the printout to the check sheet.
D05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks
Under Vehicle
(On Hoist)
E01 Remove disc brake anti-rust covers/anti-corrosion wheel film
Visually inspect rotors for rust.
NOTE:
For best rotor rust prevention, retain wheel film on vehicle until just prior to
customer delivery.
E02 Inspect tires for defects/damage and adjust tire pressure
(including spare tire)
The recommended tire inflation pressure changes with tire size, driving conditions,
and vehicle model. For precise tire pressure information, refer to the Owner’s
Manual and/or tire information label located on the vehicle.
Sidewall “Maximum” cold tire inflation pressure should not be used for
normal driving.
E03 Activate tire pressure monitor
E04 Install wheel covers/caps/spare tire wheel covers*
E05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks
Road Test
Page 4 of 5
A complete road test helps assure customer satisfaction. Drive vehicle over a variety of
road surfaces and driving conditions. Check for unusual noises and driving performance.
F01 Check cold engine operation
Check starting and fast idle operation performance.
F02 Check engine operation during warm-up
Check that engine operates smoothly during warm-up.
Check for unusual noise, engine vibration, rough idle, etc.
F03 Check engine at normal operating temperature
Check engine performance over a broad range of driving conditions, including idle
quality, acceleration, cruise, and deceleration.
F04 Check automatic transmission operation
Check automatic transmission operation, including operation in each range, neutral
start switch, and shift lock system.
F05 Check brake and parking brake operation
Check brake function, including unusual noise, parking brake performance, and all
related brake system indicator lights.
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
2007 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD099-06
August 16, 2006
Road Test
(Continued)
F06 Check steering operation and off-center/vehicle pull/flutter
Check steering function.
Check steering off-center/vehicle pull/flutter.
F07 Inspect for abnormal noises and vibration
F08 Inspect for squeaks and rattles
F09 Check heater and A/C operation
F10 Check cruise control operation
Check cruise control, including On-Off switch, “SET/COAST,” “RESUME/ACCEL,”
and “CANCEL” functions.
F11 Check front seat heater operation*
F12 Set/calibrate compass*
F13 Check Rear Height Control Air Suspension*
Final
Inspection
& Cleaning
G01 Remove interior protective covers, unnecessary labels, tags, etc.
(Remove protective covers just before delivery to the customer)
Remove plastic covers from door panels, seats, head restraints, and sun visors,
as required.
Remove labels, tags, and stickers (except those containing owner information).
NOTE:
Consumer information labels, such as airbag information warning and bumper
information labels, MUST be left on the vehicle until delivery to a retail customer.
G02
G03
G04
G05
G06
G07
G08
G09
Visually inspect all interior parts for installation, damage, fit, dirt, etc.
Remove Rapgard TM protective film
Wash and clean vehicle
Inspect paint finish for scratches, chips, rust, dents, damage, etc.
Install roof rack cross bars
Install receiver towing hitch cap
Inspect exterior body parts for proper installation, damage, rust, etc.
Place oil change sticker on inside of windshield, top left corner
Complete the mileage or date recommendation and apply the oil change reminder
sticker to the inside of the windshield, top left corner. You may use your current oil
change reminder sticker or order new stickers by calling 1–800–527–6283.
G10 Install front and rear license plates
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
Page 5 of 5
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 16, 2004
DIRECT TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING SYSTEM
Models:
’04 – ’07 4Runner
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S December 21, 2006: 2007 model year has been added to Applicable Vehicles.
S August 19, 2005: 2006 model year has been added to Applicable Vehicles.
The “Required SSTs” section has been updated to the current software version.
S January 12, 2005: Applicable Vehicles has been updated to include 2005 model year.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
NOTE:
Read this TSB in its entirety BEFORE performing any diagnosis to the Tire Pressure
Warning System.
Introduction
A direct Tire Pressure Warning System (TPWS) is now standard equipment on all
2004 – 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
A tire pressure sensor (or tire pressure monitor) is attached to each wheel directly
sensing the air pressure of each tire. The Tire Pressure Warning System detects the
pressure of each tire, including the spare tire, and illuminates a Tire Pressure Warning
Light ( ! ) to inform the driver of low tire pressure.
Each pressure sensor has a unique ID number. When tires are swapped, wheels
changed, or any work is preformed on a tire, these ID numbers must be recorded. In the
event that the IDs are not recorded when service is performed, it will be necessary to
register the pressure sensor ID numbers.
Individual tire pressure sensors need to be registered when:
S Tire pressure monitor ID numbers of the Data List are incorrect.
S Replacing the tire pressure monitor valve sub-assembly.
S Replacing the tire pressure monitor ECU.
S Performing a tire swap from vehicle to vehicle.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2004 – 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 6
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG001-04
Title:
DIRECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM – PG001-04 Revised
Required
SSTs
ITEM
NO.
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
March 16, 2004
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
TOY220036
1
9
01002744
1
9
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
1
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required
S 12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
(P/N 01002593–005) with version 13.0a Software
(or later) is required
CAN Interface Module Kit*
2
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required
* Essential SSTs.
** Refers to drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, CAN Interface Modules, Program Cards, or other
SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Page 2 of 6
DIRECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM – PG001-04 Revised
Tire Pressure
Adjustment
Procedure
March 16, 2004
Locating the Tire Pressure Sensor ID
It may be necessary to physically locate the tire pressure sensor ID numbers if:
S You are replacing one or more tire pressure sensors.
S No tire pressure sensor ID numbers are present in the Data List.
S Tires have been swapped for any reason and original ID numbers were not recorded.
Follow the screen flow below to locate and identify the current tire pressure sensor
ID numbers.
A
TOYOTA
DIAGNOSTIC TOOLSET
PROGRAM CARD
Version 13.0a
B
C
*APPLICATION SELECT*
FUNCTION SELECT
FOR NORTH AMERICA
1: DIAGNOSIS
2: CUSTOMIZE
3: ECU REPROGRAM
08/01/05
PRESS [ENTER]
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
9:
0:
OBD/MOBD
ENHANCED OBD II
CARB OBD II
BREAK–OUT BOX
NVH
AUTOPROBE
O2 RPM CHECK
SNAPSHOT REVIEW
SETUP
GAS ANALYSIS
D
E
F
VEHICLE SELECT
OBD/MOBD MENU
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
TIRE PRESSURE
NEW VEHICLE
(Select appropriate 4Runner)
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
CODES (ALL)
ENGINE AND ECT
ABS / VSC
TIRE PRESSURE
CCS
IMMOBILISER
SRS AIRBAG
BODY
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
4: SNAPSHOT
5: UTILITY
7: SIGNAL CHECK
G
MODE STATUS NORMAL
MAIN TIRE . . . . . . . . . . . 5
2ND TIRE . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
SELECT SW . . . . . . MAIN
VEHICLE SPD . . . . 0MPH
REGIT ID1 C$0#######
REGIT ID2 C$0#######
REGIT ID3 C$0#######
REGIT ID4 C$0#######
REGIT ID5 C$0#######
TRANS STATUS . . FINISH
INITIAL SW . . . . . . . . OFF
NOTE: Each REGIT ID1 – ID5 is unique for every sensor.
Be sure to record these ID numbers BEFORE attempting
registration (example of a valid ID number: C$0BB90030).
The last seven digits of the ID number are the actual
transmitter ID. If these ID numbers are not unique,
proceed to page 3 and locate the physical ID numbers.
Page 3 of 6
DIRECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM – PG001-04 Revised
Tire Pressure
Adjustment
Procedure
(Continued)
March 16, 2004
Scroll through the Data List to the REGIT ID1, ID2, ID3, ID4 and ID5. These are the ID
numbers that are currently registered to the vehicle. Write down the transmitter ID
numbers from the Data List, or use the transmitter ID numbers that were obtained from
each tire pressure sensor. If replacing one sensor, the current transmitter ID numbers
must be written down BEFORE the registration procedure can be performed. If REGIT
ID1, ID2, ID3, ID4 and ID5 display all zeros or “#” signs, there are no current ID numbers
registered in the Tire Pressure Monitoring System. Follow the steps below if there are no
codes present on the Data List.
If the ID numbers were present, proceed to “Tire Pressure ID Registration
Procedure” on page 5.
Follow the procedure below to locate the tire pressure sensor ID numbers on
each sensor:
1. Deflate tire and break the top bead.
CAUTION:
Extreme caution must be used to ensure that the tire removal arm does not break the
tire pressure sensor while attempting to break the bead on the rim.
2. Depress the tire enough to inspect the tire pressure sensor.
NOTE:
It is not necessary to remove the tire from the rim to inspect for this ID.
3. On the front of the sensor there is a 7–digit ID number as shown in the figure below.
Write this number down for future reference (it will be input using the Diagnostic
Tester).
7–Digit ID Number
4. Reseat the tire back to the wheel and set the tire pressure of all wheels to the
specified value.
5. Remount the tire and wheel assembly to the vehicle.
6. Torque all wheels to the vehicle according to vehicle recommendations.
7. Go to the “Tire Pressure ID Registration Procedure” on page 5.
Page 4 of 6
DIRECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM – PG001-04 Revised
Tire
Pressure ID
Registration
Procedure
March 16, 2004
1. Connect the Diagnostic Tester
to DLC3.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the
ON position.
Toyota
Diagnostic
Tester
DLC3
CAN Interface Module
Follow the screen flow below:
A
TOYOTA
DIAGNOSTIC TOOLSET
PROGRAM CARD
Version 13.0a
B
C
*APPLICATION SELECT*
FUNCTION SELECT
FOR NORTH AMERICA
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
9:
0:
1: DIAGNOSIS
2: CUSTOMIZE
3: ECU REPROGRAM
08/01/05
PRESS [ENTER]
D
E
VEHICLE SELECT
OBD/MOBD MENU
NEW VEHICLE
(Select appropriate 4Runner)
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
9:
CODES (ALL)
ENGINE AND ECT
ABS / VSC
TIRE PRESSURE
CCS
IMMOBILISER
SRS AIRBAG
BODY
BACK–DOOR
OBD/MOBD
ENHANCED OBD II
CARB OBD II
BREAK–OUT BOX
NVH
AUTOPROBE
O2 RPM CHECK
SNAPSHOT REVIEW
SETUP
GAS ANALYSIS
F
↓
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
TIRE PRESSURE
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
4: SNAPSHOT
5: UTILITY
7: SIGNAL CHECK
(continued next page)
Page 5 of 6
DIRECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM – PG001-04 Revised
Tire
Pressure ID
Registration
Procedure
(Continued)
March 16, 2004
(continued from previous page)
G
H
UTILITY
TIRE PRESSURE
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
1: REGIST TIRE SET
Tires are registered in the
MAIN SET
The registration
process will take
300 seconds. Do you
wish to continue?
PRESS [YES] or [NO]
I
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
Register all
transmitter ID for
all tires including
the spare tire
within 300 seconds.
Codes are printed
on each transmitter.
PRESS [ENTER]
[YES]
J*
(See Note)
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
Total Tires: 5
Number of inputted
ID codes: 0
Time: 300 seconds
PRESS [ENTER]
K
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
THE REGISTRATION
SUCCEEDED.
PRESS [ENTER]
* NOTE:
S Ensure that all 5 ID numbers are input.
S Down arrow on Diagnostic Tester creates alpha characters.
S Up arrow on Diagnostic Tester creates numeric characters.
S Left and right arrow on Diagnostic Tester to scroll characters.
3. View Data List and ensure that all tires are reading tire pressure and temperature
correctly. Drive the vehicle and ensure that the tire pressure warning light ( ! ) does
not illuminate.
Page 6 of 6
Technical Service
BULLETIN
January 26, 2006
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR
IN-STOCK VEHICLES & PRE-DELIVERY
Models:
All Models & Model Years
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S November 28, 2006: “Required SSTs” have been updated (SST P/N 00002–MCGR8
has been added). “Recommended Equipment” has been removed (superseded by
SST P/N 00002–MCGR8). Screen prints and text have been updated in the “Battery
Inspection Procedure”. “Battery Service Procedure” has been renamed “Battery
Inspection Results”. Two sections have been added for SST P/N 00002–MCGR8:
“Battery Charging Procedure” and “Battery Charging Results”.
PLEASE READ ENTIRE TSB.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. PG017–02.
TSB No. PG017–02 is now obsolete and should be discarded.
Introduction
A battery in a stored vehicle is subject to conditions that can reduce its performance and
life. These conditions include storage period, temperature, parasitic drain, and battery
load. Because of these factors, battery inspection and maintenance are required in order
to ensure proper operation and optimal battery life.
As a matter of policy, Toyota does not provide battery warranty coverage for discharged
and/or failed batteries due to lack of maintenance. It is the dealer’s responsibility to
maintain the specified State of Charge (SOC) of the vehicle’s battery while in stock and
assure proper State of Charge (SOC) at delivery.
To eliminate customer service concerns due to an undercharged battery during the first
few weeks of ownership, all dealers should check battery State of Charge (SOC) and
recharge, if necessary, within 48 hours of delivery to customers.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All models and model years.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 10
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG001-06
Title:
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Required
SSTs
ITEM
NO.
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
January 26, 2006
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
00002–V8150–KIT
1
19
00002–MCGR8
1
N/A***
Digital Battery System Analyzer*
1
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set
are required
GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station*
2
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set
are required
*
Essential SSTs.
** Drawer number in SST Storage System.
*** Not located in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
S The Digital Battery System Analyzer (P/N 00002–V8150–KIT) supersedes the
Midtronics MICROPRO 815 Digital Battery Tester (P/N 00002–MP815–T).
P/N 00002–MP815–T is now obsolete.
S The GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station (P/N 00002–MCGR8) supersedes the
Automatic Trickle Charger (P/N 00002–YA122–01) and Fast Battery Chargers
(Associated P/N ASE6003 and Christie P/N CAPPDQ). P/N 00002–YA122–01,
ASE6003, and CAPPDQ are now obsolete.
S Additional SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Battery
Inspection
Procedure
All vehicles are to be inspected according to the procedures listed below using the Digital
Battery System Analyzer (P/N 00002–V8150–KIT) no more than 48 hours prior to
customer vehicle delivery.
IMPORTANT NOTE FOR HYBRID VEHICLES:
In hybrid vehicles, the Digital Battery System Analyzer (SST P/N 00002–V8150–KIT) is
to be used ONLY on the AUXILIARY (12 volt) battery.
1. Connect test clamps to the battery. (If the analyzer does NOT power up automatically,
press the POWER button.)
2. Select the correct USER ID
(if applicable) and press the NEXT
soft key.
Page 2 of 10
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Inspection
Procedure
(Continued)
January 26, 2006
3. Enter USER PIN (if applicable) and
press the NEXT soft key.
NOTE:
For details on defining USER ID or PIN,
refer to the NVS–8150 Instruction Manual.
4. Press the NEXT soft key
(if applicable) when the HELLO
screen appears to proceed to the
Main Menu.
5. Choose BATTERY TEST and press
the SELECT soft key.
6. Select IN VEHICLE and press the
NEXT soft key.
Page 3 of 10
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Inspection
Procedure
(Continued)
7. Select MODEL and press the NEXT
soft key.
NOTE:
S “MODEL” or “STOCK #” MUST be
used to receive a warranty code if
the tester determines that the
battery is bad.
S “MODEL” and “STOCK #” are linked
to custom algorithms and are the
most accurate testing procedures.
8. Select the appropriate model and
press the NEXT soft key.
9. Select OEM battery type and press
the NEXT soft key.
10. Choose the correct battery (model
number and CCA) and press the
NEXT soft key.
Page 4 of 10
January 26, 2006
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Inspection
Procedure
(Continued)
January 26, 2006
11. Aim the infrared (IR) temperature
measurement sensor at the
negative (–) battery post and
press the NEXT soft key.
The battery is now being tested. The
progress bar fills in across the screen
while testing.
12. Read or print the battery test results
(press the PRINT soft key to print).
Battery
Inspection
Results
Once the test completes, proceed with one of the 5 procedures below according to the
BATTERY CONDITION results.
1. Battery Condition: “GOOD BATTERY”
Return the battery to service.
2. Battery Condition: “GOOD–RECHARGE”
Fully charge the battery using the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station
(P/N 00002–MCGR8) and return it to service.
Page 5 of 10
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Inspection
Results
(Continued)
January 26, 2006
3. Battery Condition: “CHARGE & RETEST”
Fully charge the battery using the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station
(P/N 00002–MCGR8) and retest.
NOTE:
Failure to fully charge the battery before retesting may cause false readings.
4. Battery Condition: “REPLACE BATTERY”
Replace the battery.
NOTE:
A REPLACE BATTERY result may also mean a poor connection between the battery
cables and the battery. Retest the battery using the out–of–vehicle test before
replacing it.
5. Battery Condition: “BAD CELL–REPLACE”
Replace the battery. The decision indicates a bad cell within the battery.
CAUTION:
S If “FROZEN BATTERY” is displayed as the test result, allow the battery to reach a
temperature of 40°F (4°C) before retesting.
S NEVER CHARGE A FROZEN BATTERY. GASES MAY FORM, CRACKING THE CASE
AND CAUSING BATTERY ACID TO LEAK.
Battery
Charging
Procedure
If the battery requires charging, follow the procedures below using the GR8 Battery
Diagnostic Station (P/N 00002–MCGR8).
1. Connect the charger cables to the positive (+) and negative (–) battery terminals.
2. Plug the charger into the 110V outlet and turn the switch to the ON position.
3. Select appropriate USER ID
(if applicable) and press the NEXT
soft key.
Page 6 of 10
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Charging
Procedure
(Continued)
January 26, 2006
4. Enter USER PIN (if applicable) and
press the NEXT soft key.
NOTE:
For details on defining USER ID or PIN,
refer to the GR8 Instruction Manual.
5. Press the NEXT soft key when the
HELLO screen appears to proceed to
the Main Menu.
6. Select CHARGING from the Main
Menu screen and press the SELECT
soft key.
7. Select DIAGNOSTIC from the Charge
Menu screen and press the SELECT
soft key.
Page 7 of 10
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Charging
Procedure
(Continued)
8. Select IN VEHICLE and press the
NEXT soft key.
9. Select MODEL and press the NEXT
soft key.
NOTE:
S “MODEL” or “STOCK #” MUST be
used to receive a warranty code if
the tester determines that the
battery is bad.
S “MODEL” and “STOCK #” are linked
to custom algorithms and are the
most accurate testing procedures.
10. Select the appropriate model and
press the NEXT soft key.
11. Select OEM battery type and press
the NEXT soft key.
Page 8 of 10
January 26, 2006
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Charging
Procedure
(Continued)
January 26, 2006
12. Choose the correct battery (model
number and CCA) and press the
NEXT soft key.
The battery will be tested before
charging will occur. The progress bar
fills in across the screen while testing.
The charger starts charging upon
completion of testing. The screen
displays the status of charge.
13. Read or print the battery test results.
P 1/4: BATTERY RESULTS
P 2/4: STATE OF CHARGE (SOC)
P 3/4: STATE OF HEALTH (SOH)
P 4/4: WARRANTY CODE
To print:
Align the Midtronics IR Printer
(P/N 00002–A0870, component of
P/N 00002–V8150–KIT) in front of the
IR port on the charger and select the
PRINT soft key.
Page 9 of 10
BATTERY MAINTENANCE FOR IN–STOCK VEHICLES & PRE–DELIVERY – PG001-06 Revised
Battery
Charging
Results
January 26, 2006
Once the test completes, proceed with 1 of the 3 procedures below according to the
BATTERY CONDITION results.
1. Battery Condition: “GOOD BATTERY”
Return the battery to service.
2. Battery Condition: “REPLACE BATTERY”
Replace the battery. Print the RESULTS screen for WARRANTY CODE by pressing
the PRINT soft key.
NOTE:
A REPLACE BATTERY result may also mean a poor connection between the battery
cables and the battery. Retest the battery using the out–of–vehicle test before
replacing it.
3. Battery Condition: “BAD CELL–REPLACE”
Replace the battery. The decision indicates a bad cell within the battery. Print the
RESULTS screen for WARRANTY CODE by pressing the PRINT soft key.
Battery
Replacement
If a vehicle battery needs to be replaced
for a warrantable condition, complete a
Warranty Battery Label and affix it to the
failed battery for proper warranty parts
and claim processing. Include the
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
and warranty code on the Warranty
Battery Label.
WARRANTY BATTERY LABEL
ETIQUETA PARA BATERIA DE GARANTIA
(Please Print / Llénese con Letra de Molde Por Favor)
Dealer Code
Código de Agencia
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
Número de Identificación de Vehículo (NIV)
Repair Order No.
No. de Orden de Reparación
Veh. Date of First Use
Fecha de Primer
Uso del Veh.
08/02
Battery
Maintenance
Repair Date
Fecha de Reparación
Failure Code
Código de Falla
Original Install Date
Fecha de Instalación Original
(Svc. part replacement only/
solamente para el reemplazo
de partes de servicio)
Battery Mos. In Svc.
Número de meses que
Batería está en servicio
00404–BTTRY–LABEL
Recommended Battery Maintenance:
In addition to this new pre–delivery battery test, a monthly battery inspection is still
required for stored vehicles. If your dealership is located in an area subject to extreme
temperatures (hot or cold), periodic maintenance may need to be performed
more frequently.
To reduce parasitic battery drain on vehicles in storage for one week or more, the
negative (–) battery cable should always be disconnected to reduce battery discharge.
When the negative (–) battery cable is reconnected, please check and reset electrical
components, such as the clock, radio, etc., and re–initialize all applicable
systems/functions.
Refer to the appropriate model and year service bulletins for specific details.
For example:
S TSB No. PD008–05, “Power System Initialization During PDS” (2005 model year)
S TSB No. PD014–06, “Power System Initialization During PDS” (2006 model year)
Page 10 of 10
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 2, 2005
TIRE POSITIONING BEFORE NEW
VEHICLE DELIVERY
Models:
’05 – ’07 All Toyota & Scion
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S May 26, 2006: 2007 model year has been added to Applicable Vehicles.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
During the manufacturing process, tire characteristics are measured. Tires are then
mounted on the vehicle as matched sets to help reduce conditions such as pulling or
drifting. If the wheels are replaced or refinished before vehicle delivery, it is important
that the tires remain on the vehicle in the same location and in the same direction
of rotation.
Please refer to the following procedure to ensure that the original tires stay in the same
location on the vehicle.
Applicable
Vehicles
Installation
Procedure
S All 2005 – 2007 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
1. Mark the tire installation position on the inward facing tire sidewall.
Example: Front Right = FR, Front Left = FL, Rear Right = RR, Rear Left = RL
2. Install the original tires on the new or refinished wheels with the marked side
facing inwards.
3. Place the tire/wheel assemblies on the vehicle in the marked positions.
NOTE:
Torque the wheel nuts to the proper torque value in sequence.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG002-05
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
November 28, 2006
Introduction
DIRECTĆTYPE TIRE PRESSURE
WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS
Models:
’04 – ’07 Applicable Toyota & Scion
The Tire Pressure Warning System (TPWS) monitors the difference in tire pressure in
all four or five tires (if the vehicle is equipped with a full-size spare tire) through radio
wave signals from a tire pressure valve/sensor mounted in each wheel.
This bulletin provides an overview and diagnostic information for the direct-type TPWS.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 2004 – 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
S 2005 – 2006 model year Tundra vehicles.
S 2005 – 2007 model year Sequoia vehicles.
S 2006 – 2007 model year Land Cruiser, Prius, RAV4, and Tacoma vehicles.
S 2007 model year Avalon, Camry, Solara, and Scion tC vehicles.
Required
SSTs
ITEM
NO.
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
TOY220036
1
9
01002744
1
9
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
1
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
S 12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
(P/N 01002593–005) with version 13.4a Software
(or later) is required.
CAN Interface Module Kit*
2
NOTE:
S All components from this kit/set are required.
* Essential SSTs.
** Drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, CAN Interface Modules, Program Cards, or other
SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 12
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG004-06
Title:
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Summary of
TPWS/
Component
Operation
November 28, 2006
The following illustration is an example of the TPWS component locations on
2004 – 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles:
Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
Combination Meter
(Low Tire Pressure
Warning Light)
Tire Pressure
Sensor Front RH
Tire Pressure
Monitor Receiver
(With Antenna)
Tire Pressure
Sensor Front LH
Tire Pressure
Sensor Rear LH
Tire Pressure
Sensor Rear RH
Tire Pressure
Sensor Spare Tire
Tire Pressure Sensor
Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
DLC3
Tire Pressure
Monitor Receiver
(with Antenna)
Meter
Tire Pressure Sensor
For exact location of each vehicle’s TPWS components, refer to the Technical Information
System (TIS), applicable model and model year Repair Manual: Tire and Wheel (refer to
component or parts location). For additional information on the TPWS components and
operation, refer to TIS, applicable model and model year New Car Features: Chassis and
Drivetrain.
Page 2 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Summary of
TPWS/
Component
Operation
(Continued)
November 28, 2006
S Tire Pressure Warning Valve/Sensor:
Each wheel (including the spare tire on certain vehicles) has a tire pressure warning
valve/sensor integrated into the air valve with a unique ID number that measures the
tire pressure and tire temperature and then transmits the information to the
antenna/receiver mounted inside the vehicle through a radio wave signal. The unique
ID number must be manually entered into the ECU using the Diagnostic Tester
whenever the tire pressure warning valve/sensor is replaced or after a tire and
wheel are exchanged.
Vehicles equipped with a tire pressure warning valve/sensor inside the spare tire are
listed in the following table:
MODEL
MODEL YEAR
4Runner
2004 – 2007
Avalon
2007
Camry (with Full-size Spare)
2007
Land Cruiser
2006 – 2007
RAV4
2006 – 2007
Sequoia
2005 – 2007
Solara (with Full-size Spare)
2007
Tacoma
2006 – 2007
Tundra
2005 – 2006
Valve Portion
Air Hole
ID Code
Disc Wheel
Rim
Valve/Sensor Position
Grommet
Nut
NOTE:
S All Japan-built vehicles require the tire pressure warning valve/sensors to be
activated (”wake up”) during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS).
S Each tire pressure warning valve/sensor is equipped with a lithium battery that has
an average life span of 10 years.
S If a tire pressure warning valve/sensor is removed from the wheel, the grommet
MUST be inspected and replaced if damaged.
Page 3 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Summary of
TPWS/
Component
Operation
(Continued)
November 28, 2006
S Tire Pressure Warning System Antenna/Receiver:
The antenna/receiver receives each tire pressure, tire temperature, and the unique
tire pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers through radio wave signals from
the tire pressure warning valve/sensors and then transmits the information to the
TPWS ECU.
S Tire Pressure Warning System ECU:
The ECU takes each tire pressure, tire temperature, and unique tire pressure warning
valve/sensor ID information from the antenna/receiver and compares it to the
specified value, which was registered during PDS. If the information received does
NOT match the specified value registered in the ECU, it will transmit a signal to
illuminate the Tire Pressure Warning System Indicator Light located on the
combination meter. If the ECU is replaced, it is necessary to manually enter the tire
pressure valve/sensor ID numbers using the Diagnostic Tester.
S Tire Pressure Warning System
Indicator Light:
The Tire Pressure Warning System
Indicator Light on the combination
meter is illuminated or flashes
continuously when the ECU senses
that the tire pressure, tire
temperature, and/or unique ID
number does NOT match the
specified value registered in the ECU.
Tire Pressure Warning System Indicator Light
Conditions for the Tire Pressure
Warning System Indicator Light
“ON” or “Flashing” are listed in the
following table:
Page 4 of 12
CONDITION
CAUSE
REPAIR
After turning the key ON, the
TPWS Indicator Light illuminates
for 3 seconds and then turns OFF
Normal —
“System Check”
Normal Condition
TPWS Indicator Light is ON and
will NOT turn OFF
Low tire pressure has
been detected
Check that all tire pressures are set
to the tire inflation pressure
indicated on the vehicle loading
specification label
After turning the key ON, the
TPWS Indicator Light flashes for
1 minute and then turns ON
steady or flashes continuously
System Failure
See the “System Concerns &
Repair Methods” sections in
this TSB
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Summary of
TPWS/
Component
Operation
(Continued)
November 28, 2006
S Initialization/“SET” Switch:
When initializing the TPWS, the present tire pressure is set as the standard pressure
(for example: 32 psi). The TPWS determines a decrease in air pressure by comparing
the standard pressure to the tire inflation pressure received from the tire pressure
warning valve/sensor.
Reasons for initializing the system include:
S When rotating tires that have different tire pressures in the front and rear.
S When changing or adjusting the tire pressure.
S When changing tire size or when tires are replaced.
The vehicles listed in the following table are equipped with an
Initialization/“SET” switch:
MODEL
MODEL YEAR
Avalon
2007
Camry
2007
Land Cruiser
2006 – 2007
Prius
2006 – 2007
Scion tC
2007
Solara
2007
Sequoia
2005 – 2007
Tacoma
2006 – 2007
Tundra
2005 – 2006
ILLUSTRATION OF INITIALIZATION/“SET” SWITCH
S “MAIN/2nd” Switch (Land Cruiser vehicles ONLY):
Land Cruiser is the ONLY Toyota vehicle with the “MAIN/2nd” switch. This allows the
owner to have two different sets of tires and wheels, with two different sets of tire
pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers. For example, the second set would be
used for snow tires. Therefore, register both the main and the second set of tire
pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers in the TPWS ECU using the Diagnostic
Tester. Depending on what set of tire pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers are
being registered, the “MAIN/2nd” switch must be set in the correct position (i.e.,
“MAIN” for regular use tires and “2nd” for snow use tires).
S “MAIN/2nd” switch in the UP position — The TPWS ECU is programmed to read
the main set of tire pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers.
S “MAIN/2nd” switch in the DOWN position — The TPWS ECU is programmed to
read the second set of tire pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers.
TPWS “MAIN/2nd” Switch
Page 5 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Diagnostic
Tester Setup
When diagnosing the TPWS with the Diagnostic Tester, it must be set up to read the tire
pressures in “psi – gauge” (psi – g). Follow the screens below from the Diagnostic Tester
to convert the tire pressures to psi – g.
A
B
*APPLICATION SELECT*
TOYOTA
DIAGNOSTIC TOOLSET
PROGRAM CARD
Version 13.4a
1: DIAGNOSIS
2 CUSTOMIZE
3: ECU REPROGRAM
07/16/06
Press
D
SETUP MENU
1:
2
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
9:
Page 6 of 12
November 28, 2006
CLOCK/CALENDAR
PRINTER BAUD
PRINTER SELECT
UNIT CONVERSION
BRAND SELECT
DATA BASE SELECT
BACKLIGHT SET
ENH OBDII HELP
SELF TEST
E
UNIT CONVERSION
AIR/FUEL PRESSURE
abs gauge
gauge
kPa mmHg inHg psi
psi
inH20
C
FUNCTION SELECT FOR
NORTH AMERICA
1: OBD/MOBD
2 ENHANCED OBD II
3: CARB OBD II
4: BREAK-OUT BOX
5: NVH
6: AUTOPROBE
7: 02 RPM CHECK
8: SNAPSHOT REVIEW
9: SETUP
0: GAS ANALYSIS
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
System
Concerns &
Repair Methods
COMMON SYMPTOM
Cannot register the sensor ID
numbers in the ECU using the
Diagnostic Tester.
CAUSE
November 28, 2006
REPAIR SUGGESTIONS
TPWS ECU
is initialized.
Jump terminals TC & CG at the
DLC3 connector for 30 seconds
to reset the TPWS ECU. (Land
Cruiser: jump terminals TC & E1
at the DLC1 connector.)
Diagnostic Tester
software is incorrect
or incompatible.
Update software via TIS.
“MAIN/2nd” switch
is in the incorrect
position (Land
Cruiser ONLY).
Ensure correct switch position and
make sure loose objects do not
contact the switch.
1)Record all sensor ID numbers
from the Diagnostic Tester
Data List.
Cannot complete Pre-Delivery
Service (PDS) activation “wake
up” procedure.
Tire/wheel swapped
prior to delivery
to customer.
NOTE: Vehicles built in North
America come with the transmitter
y activated
sensors already
(
(awake).
k ) V
Vehicles
hi l b
built
il iin JJapan
require the transmitter sensors
to be activated during PDS.
Sensor ID numbers
are not registered.
DTCs:
C2111
C2112
C2113
C2114
C2115
One or more tire pressures
display “–14 psi-g” & “–40_F” on
the Diagnostic Tester Data List.
DTCs:
C2121
C2122
C2123
C2124
C2125
C2177
2)Break down tires and compare
the sensor ID numbers to what is
recorded in the TPWS ECU.
3)If incorrect, register the correct
sensor ID numbers using the
Diagnostic Tester.
1)Break down tires and record all
sensor ID numbers.
2)Register the sensor ID numbers
in the TPWS ECU using the
Diagnostic Tester.
1)Tire pressure decrease is not
fast enough.
Transmitters are
not activated
(in sleep mode).
1)Sensor ID numbers
are not registered.
2)Tire/wheel swapped
prior to delivery
to customer.
2)Loosen the valve core when
releasing air pressure from the
tire to activate (”wake up”)
the sensor (6 psi-g within
30 seconds).
1)Record all sensor ID numbers
from the Diagnostic Tester
Data List.
2)Break down tires and compare
the sensor ID numbers to what is
recorded in the TPWS ECU.
3)If incorrect, register the correct
sensor ID numbers using the
Diagnostic Tester.
TPWS ECU or
antenna/receiver
malfunction.
Refer to the diagnostic procedure
for checking the TPWS ECU and/or
antenna/receiver located in the
applicable Repair Manual on TIS.
Transmitters are
inoperative.
Replace sensors.
Page 7 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
System
Concerns &
Repair Methods
(Continued)
COMMON SYMPTOM
REPAIR SUGGESTIONS
One or more tire pressures display “–14 psi-g” & “–40_F” on the
Diagnostic Tester Data List.
Land Cruiser ONLY:
C2131
C2132
C2133
C2134
C2135
C2177
Tire pressure reads higher
than actual vehicle loading
label specification.
Page 8 of 12
CAUSE
November 28, 2006
Check position of “MAIN/2nd”
“MAIN/2nd” switch is in switch. (“MAIN” for the main set of
tires and “2nd” for second set of
the incorrect position
(Land Cruiser ONLY). tire pressure warning valve/sensor
ID numbers.)
Initialization is
incorrect or
incomplete.
Adjust and set tire pressures
according to the vehicle loading
label specification. (Label is inside
the driver’s door jamb.)
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Registration
Procedure
November 28, 2006
Registration of tire pressure warning valve/sensor ID numbers:
1. Jump TC and CG at DLC3 with the key ON and eEngine OFF for 30 seconds
(Land Cruiser — Jump TC and E1 at DLC 1).
2. Register the 7-digit IDs:
A
B
C
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
TIRE PRESSURE
UTILITY
TIRE PRESSURE
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
1: REGIST TIRE SET
4: SNAPSHOT
5: UTILITY
7: SIGNAL CHECK
Tires are registered in the
MAIN SET
The registration
process will take
300 seconds. Do you
wish to continue?
PRESS [YES] or [NO]
[ENTER]
[YES]
[ENTER]
E
D
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
Register all
transmitter ID for
all tires including
the spare tire
within 300 seconds.
Codes are printed
on each transmitter.
Total Tires: 5
Number of inputted
ID codes: 0
Time: 300 seconds
PRESS [ENTER]
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
F
UTILITY
REGIST TIRE SET
THE REGISTRATION
SUCCEEDED.
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
3. Confirm the actual tire pressure to the Diagnostic Tester Data List and set
according to the tire inflation pressure indicated on the vehicle loading
specification label.
4. Confirm that the Tire Pressure Warning System Indicator Light is OFF.
5. Push and hold the Initialization/“SET” switch (if equipped) until the Low TPWS Light
blinks 3 times and then release the switch. Keep the ignition key ON for 5 minutes for
the system to initialize.
The registration is complete.
Page 9 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
November 28, 2006
Diagnostic
Flow Chart
Low Tire Pressure
Warning Light is ON
Land Cruiser
vehicles ONLY
Check position of
“MAIN/ 2nd” switch
“2nd”
What position is
the “MAIN/2nd”
switch in?
“MAIN”
Do one or more
tires have
damage causing
an air leak?
YES
Using a tire pressure
gauge, check ALL tire
pressures (including
the spare if equipped)
with a full-size spare
Return switch to
“MAIN” position &
explain to customer
purpose of
“2nd/MAIN” switch
YES
Is the tire
pressure low?
Fix or replace tire(s)
NO
NO
1) Adjust tire pressure
according to Tire
and Loading
Information label
on driver’s
door jamb
2) Check that Low
TPWS Light goes
OFF after 5 minutes
of key ON and
engine OFF.
Did Low TPWS
Light turn OFF?
YES
Repair Complete
NO
(Continued on next page)
Page 10 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Diagnostic
Flow Chart
(Continued)
November 28, 2006
(Continued from previous page)
Use Diagnostic
Tester to check for
stored DTCs
NO DTCs
Which DTCs
are stored?
Confirm actual tire
pressure to
Diagnostic Tester
Data List
Other DTCs
Follow Diagnostic
Procedure in
Repair Manual
DTC C2111, C2112,
C2113, C2114, & C2115
HINT:
“TIREPRESS”
displays “–14 psi–g”
on Diagnostic Tester
Data List
1) From TPWS Diagnostic
Menu, select “ALL” Data List
2) Display “ALL TIREPRESS”
3) Increase tire pressure to
44 psi
4) Remove the air pressure by
6 psi for 30 seconds
HINT:
It may be necessary to
loosen the valve core to
quickly reduce the tire
pressure for each tire one at
a time.
“TIREPRESS” that does NOT
change on Diagnostic Tester
Data List when performing
step 4 is the valve/sensor
out of specification or
–14 psi–g.
DTC C2121, C2123,
C2124, C2125, C2131,
C2132, C2133, C2134,
C2135, C2177
HINT:
“TIREPRESS
displays “–14psi–g”
on Diagnostic Tester
Data List
1) From TPWS Diagnostic Menu,
select “ALL” Data List
2) Display “ALL TIREPRESS”
3) Decrease air pressure from
valve core
HINT:
“TIREPRESS” that does NOT
change on Diagnostic Tester
Data List when performing
step 3 is the valve/sensor
out of specification or –14 psi–g.
4) Repeat step 3 for each tire one
at a time
5) From Diagnostic Tester Data
List, write down “TIREPRESS”
data valve/sensor ID number
that corresponds to each tire
Are all tire pressures
displayed on
Diagnostic Tester Data
List within factory
specification?
(Continued on next page)
Page 11 of 12
DIRECT-TYPE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – PG004-06
Diagnostic
Flow Chart
(Continued)
November 28, 2006
(Continued from previous page)
Are all tire pressures
displayed on
Diagnostic Tester Data
List within factory
specification?
Remove tire from
wheel & confirm actual
valve/sensor ID
numbers to number
registered in ECU
NO
YES
Repair Complete
1) Adjust tire pressure according to Tire
and Loading Information label on driver’s
door jamb
2) Confirm the actual tire pressure to the
Diagnostic Tester Data List
3) If vehicle is equipped with
Initialization/SET switch, initialize system
by pressing & holding “SET” switch until
Low TPWS Light blinks 3 times & then
turns OFF
Page 12 of 12
NO
Is valve/sensor ID
number correct?
Register correct
valve/sensors
ID number into
ECU using
Diagnostic Tester
YES
Replace valve/sensor
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABELS
Models:
All Models
January 18, 2002
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates PG006–01 dated May 4, 2001.
Revised text is red and underlined. The changes will take place February 1, 2002.
Introduction
Replacement Certification Labels (vinyl label affixed to driver’s door or door post)
may be available from Toyota providing the request meets one of the criteria
listed below.
Certification Label Location
MFD.BY:TOYOTA MOTOR MANUFACTURING
CANADA INC. 10/01
GVWR 3935LB GAWR FR 1970LB RR 1985LB
THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO ALL APPLICABLE
FEDERAL MOTOR VEHICLE SAFETY, BUMPER, AND
THEFT PREVENTION STANDARDS IN EFFECT ON
THE DATE OF MANUFACTURE SHOWN ABOVE.
XT0XX00X0X000000
PASS.CAR
C/TR:3L5/FB14 MODEL:ZZE134L – DHPNKA
A/TM:–04A/U341F MADE IN CANADA
S26 AA01904759
Applicable
Vehicles
Certification
Label Criteria
S All Toyota vehicles.
1. The vehicle is in an accident and the label is damaged or is attached to a part that will
be replaced during the repair.
NOTE:
S Processing a new label will be delayed significantly if the original certification label
is not available.
S A replacement label MAY NOT be available if the vehicle is more than 5 years old
and the old label does not accompany this request.
2. The label is stolen.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement label, complete a copy of the form on the back of this bulletin.
Your dealer parts account will be billed $25.00 for each replacement of a damaged or
stolen label.
NOTE:
All replacement labels for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG008-02
Title:
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABEL
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
STOLEN
OTHER
MFD.BY: TOYOTAMOTOR MANUFACTURING
CANADA INC. 10/01
GVWR3935LBGAWRFR1970LBRR1985LB
THISVEHICLECONFORMSTOALLAPPLICABLE
FEDERALMOTORVEHICLESAFETY, BUMPER, AND
THEFTPREVENTIONSTANDARDS IN EFFECT ON
THE DATEOFMANUFACTURESHOWNABOVE.
XT0XX00X0X000000 PASS.CAR
C/TR:3L5/FB14MODEL:ZZE134L–DHPNKA
A/TM:–04A/U341FMADEINCANADA
S26AA01904759
REASON/EXPLANATION
ATTACH ORIGINAL LABEL HERE
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
NOTE:
Original label MUST accompany this application or order will be significantly delayed.
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD LABEL TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA 90509–2991
Technical Service
BULLETIN
November 24, 2003
ADJUSTMENT OF TIRE INFLATION
PRESSURE
Models:
’04 – ’07 4Runner
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S December 21, 2006: 2005 – 2007 model years have been added to
Applicable Vehicles.
S December 15, 2003: In Temperature Compensation Examples, word changes have
been made to clarify the calculations.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide additional details regarding the tire pressure
warning system on the 4Runner, as well as provide guidelines for temperature
compensation of tire pressure – taking into account changes in ambient temperature and
actual tire temperature.
Seasonal temperature change can dramatically alter tire pressure. In addition, popular
pencil type tire pressure gauges and service station air pumps have been proven on
many occasions to be inaccurate and misleading.
Low Tire Pressure Detection Timing:
The tire pressure at each wheel is monitored when the ignition is ON. If the tire pressure
falls below 27 PSI while the ignition is ON, the warning light will illuminate.
Tire Pressure vs. Tire Temperature:
Air in a tire expands and contracts as the temperature of the tire changes, changing the
tire’s air pressure. Tire temperature is dependent on “cold” tire pressure, driving distance
and speed, ambient temperature and road surface temperature. The “cold” tire pressure
for the 4Runner is 220 Kpa (31.9 PSI), shown as 32 PSI in the Owner’s Manual.
When adjusting tire pressures for your customer, you have to consider all of these
factors, plus the difference between the temperature in the workshop and the lowest
outside temperature you expect to have in your area in the next few weeks.
“Cold” tire pressure, as recommended by the tire manufacturer (and shown on the tire
pressure label in our vehicles), is generally considered to be the pressure in a tire that
has not been driven the previous 4 hours, and has been parked outdoors.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2004 – 2007 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG009-03
Title:
ADJUSTMENT OF TIRE INFLATION PRESSURE – PG009-03 Revised
Tire Pressure
Adjustment
November 24, 2003
Recommended Tire Pressure Adjustment:
As noted above, there are many variables that can affect tire pressure in operation.
However, you can use these guidelines to optimize the pressure when you set it in the
workshop:
S Use a high quality accurate tire pressure gauge, and check its accuracy regularly.
S Consider the difference in the air temperature in the workshop and the lowest ambient
temperature you expect in the next few weeks (especially in winter).
S Use the chart (Figure 1) to compensate for temperature of the tires when you adjust
the pressure.
S Use temperature compensation Example 1 for the spare tire.
Temperature
Compensation
Example 1
Assumed conditions:
S The vehicle’s spare tire pressure is being adjusted.
S The 4Runner has been parked overnight outside your shop (vehicle has “cold” tires),
or is the spare tire for the vehicle.
S Your workshop temperature is 68_F (20_C), and you expect the lowest ambient
temperature in your area to be 14_F (–10_C).
Calculations:
S Compute the temperature difference between the seasonable lowest temperature and
the workshop temperature: 68_F (20_C) – [14_F (–10_C)] = 54_F or 30_C.
S Using the tire pressure chart (Figure 1), find the intersection of the cold tire line at the
point corresponding to 54_F or 30_C, and read off the value on the tire pressure
change axis. In this case it would be about 4.6 PSI.
S Compute the actual tire pressure the tires should be filled to:
31.9 + 4.6 PSI = 36.5 PSI.
In this example the tires would need to be filled to 37 PSI to compensate for the seasonal
temperature difference.
Temperature
Compensation
Example 2
Assumed conditions:
S The 4Runner has been driven to your shop on surface streets for about 30 minutes
(vehicle has “warm” tires).
S Your workshop temperature is 68_F (20_C), and you expect the lowest ambient
temperature in your area to be 14_F (–10_C).
Calculations:
S Compute the temperature difference between the seasonable lowest temperature and
the workshop temperature: 68_F (20_C) – [14_F (–10_C)] = 54_F or 30_C.
S Using the tire pressure chart (Figure 1), find the intersection of the warm tire line at
the point corresponding to 54_F or 30_C, and read off the value on the tire pressure
change axis. In this case it would be about 6.7 PSI.
S Compute the actual tire pressure the tires should be filled to:
31.9 + 6.7 PSI = 38.6 PSI.
In this example the tires would need to be filled to 39 PSI to compensate for the seasonal
temperature difference and the heat in the tires from the short drive to your dealer.
Page 2 of 3
ADJUSTMENT OF TIRE INFLATION PRESSURE – PG009-03 Revised
Temperature
Compensation
Example 3
November 24, 2003
Assumed conditions:
S The 4Runner has been driven to your shop on the highway for at least 60 minutes
(vehicle has “hot” tires).
S Your workshop temperature is 68_F (20_C), and you expect the lowest ambient
temperature in your area to be 14_F (–10_C).
Calculations:
S Compute the temperature difference between the seasonable lowest temperature and
the workshop temperature: 68_F (20_C) – [14_F (–10_C)] = 54_F or 30_C.
S Using the tire pressure chart (Figure 1), find the intersection of the hot tire line at the
point corresponding to 54_F or 30_C, and read off the value on the tire pressure
change axis. In this case it would be about 9.0 PSI.
S Compute the actual tire pressure the tires should be filled to:
31.9 + 9.0 PSI = 40.9 PSI.
In this example the tires would need to be filled to 41 PSI to compensate for the seasonal
temperature difference and the heat in the tires from the long, high–speed drive to your
dealer.
From these examples you can see that while the “cold” tire pressure specified for the tires
is 32 PSI in the Owner’s Manual, you may need to inflate the tires to 41 PSI, or more,
depending on seasonal weather conditions and initial tire temperature.
Figure 1: Tire Pressure Chart
14
13
12
Tire Pressure Change (PSI)
Tire Pressure
Chart
11
Example 3
10
9
8
7
Example 2
6
5
Example 1
4
3
2
1
0
0_F or
0_C
18_F or
10_C
36_F or
20_C
54_F or
30_C
72_F or
40_C
90_F or
50_C
108_F or
60_C
Temperature DIFFERENCE Between Seasonable Lowest Temperature and
Workshop Temperature
Cold Tire – Car not driven for 4 hours and parked outside prior to air
pressure leak
Warm Tire – Car has just been driven a short distance in traffic
Hot Tire – Car has just been driven for at least 1 hour of highway driving
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT VIN PLATES
Models:
All Models
January 18, 2002
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates PG007–01 dated May 4, 2001.
Revised text is red and underlined. The changes will take place February 1, 2002.
Introduction
Replacement VIN plates (metal plates riveted to dashboard) may be available from
Toyota providing the request meets the criteria listed below.
VIN Plate Location
Applicable
Vehicles
Replacement
VIN Plate
Criteria
S All Toyota vehicles.
S The vehicle is in an accident and the plate is damaged.
NOTE:
The original plate to be replaced MUST accompany the request.
NOTE:
If a plate is stolen, be sure to contact the State Police or your State’s Department of
Motor Vehicles (DMV). In most cases the State DMV will issue a unique number so that
the original number can be included on stolen vehicle listings. If this is the case, a
replacement plate is NOT available from Toyota. However, the original VIN, NOT the
state issued VIN, must be used on all warranty claims.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement plate, complete a copy of the form on the back of this page.
Note that the damaged VIN plate MUST accompany the request form. Your dealer parts
account will be billed $25.00 for each replacement of a damaged plate.
NOTE:
All replacement plates for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG009-02
Title:
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT VIN PLATE
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
OTHER
REASON/EXPLANATION
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
ATTACH DAMAGED PLATE HERE
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD PLATE TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA. 90509–2991
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
All ’06 Toyota & Scion & ’07 Camry
February 22, 2007
Introduction
This TSB contains information regarding Special Service Tools (SSTs) distributed or
added to the SST program during the 2006 model year as well as those that apply to
2007 model year Camry. Essential SSTs are listed by tool number, tool name, model
application, and SST Storage System drawer number.
NOTE:
Special Service Tools can be ordered through the Toyota/Scion SST Program by
calling SPX/OTC at 1–800–933–8335.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All 2006 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
S 2007 model year Camry.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS001-07
Title:
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS – SS001-07
Essential
Special
Service Tools
TOOL NUMBER
February 22, 2007
APPLICATION
DRW*
09216–42010
Belt Tension Wrench Set
S This tool is designed to assist the
technician servicing the engine
V–drive belts.
Camry,
RAV4
1
09387–00130
Counter Drive Gear Nut Wrench
S This tool is used in conjunction with
a torque wrench to properly torque the
counter drive gear nut on
automatic transaxles.
Camry
1
09564–33010
Differential Preload Adapter
S This tool is used in conjunction with a
torque wrench to assist in determining/
adjusting counter driven gear preload on
automatic transaxles.
Camry
1
09961–01270
Torque Wrench Adapter
S This tool is used in conjunction with a
torque wrench to assist in tightening the
front suspension lower arm sub–assembly.
RAV4
1
09223–56010–01
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacer
S This tool will have a primary function
of assisting in the installation of rear main
oil seals. It can also be used to install the
front disc brake dust cover to the axle hub
bearing assembly.
Various
Models
7
00002–GTMAR
Gap Tool
S This tool is used to determine body panel
measurements and interior trim fit.
ALL
20
Various
Models
21
ALL
**
09843–18060
00002–MCGR8
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
SRS Service Wire
S This wire will help validate and test
SRS circuit integrity and assist
with diagnosis.
Battery Diagnostic Station
S The GR8 Battery Diagnostic station will
diagnose and automatically charge all
Toyota/Scion 12–volt batteries (including
hybrid AMGs) in 1 hour or less. It also has
jump start capability and a “Power Supply
Mode” for maintaining ideal battery
conditions while flash
reprogramming vehicles.
* Drawer number in SST Storage System.
** Essential SSTs not located in SST Storage System.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 26, 2007
Introduction
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH
REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE
Models:
’01 – ’08 Applicable Toyota
Flash reprogramming allows the ECU software to be updated without replacing
the ECU. Flash calibration updates for specific vehicle models/ECUs are released
as field–fix procedures described in individual service bulletins. This bulletin details the
Techstream ECU flash reprogramming process and outlines use of the Technical
Information System (TIS) and the Calibration Update Wizard (CUW).
Flash calibration updates can only be applied to the vehicle/ECU combination for which
they are intended. ECUs have internal security that will not allow them to be programmed
with another ECU’s information.
NOTE:
Electronic Control Unit (ECU) is a Toyota term used to describe integrated
computerized devices responsible for managing the operation of a system or
subsystem. For the purposes of this bulletin, the term “ECU” is used as a generic
label for the following SAE J1930 standard references:
S Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
S Engine Control Module (ECM)
S Transmission Control Module (TCM)
S Or any other Toyota specific control unit
Applicable
Vehicles
S 2001 – 2008 model year applicable Toyota vehicles.
NOTE:
NOT all models are capable of flash reprogramming.
Parts
Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
N/A
00451–00001–LBL
Authorized Modification Label
1
NOTE:
Authorized Modification Labels may be ordered in packages of 25 from the Materials
Distribution Center (MDC) through the Dealer Daily Dealer Support Materials System,
or by calling the MDC at 1–800–622–2033.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 23
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS002-07
Title:
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Required
Tools &
Equipment
REQUIRED EQUIPMENT
April 26, 2007
SUPPLIER
PART NUMBER
QTY
ADE
TSPKG1
1
TIS Techstream*
NOTE: Software version 2.00.008
or later is required.
NOTE:
Additional Techstream units may be ordered by calling ADE at 1–800–368–6787.
REQUIRED SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
SUPPLIER
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
Digital Battery System Analyzer*
SPX/OTC
00002–V8150–KIT
1
19
GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station*
SPX/OTC
00002–MCGR8
1
–
*
**
Essential SSTs.
Drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Page 2 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Process
Overview
April 26, 2007
Techstream ECU flash reprogramming is a 4–step process:
1. Verify the vehicle’s applicability for recalibration and locate desired calibration file.
Vehicle applicability can be determined by the following methods:
S Techstream ECU Reprogram Function
S Techstream Health Check Function
NOTE:
Techstream will automatically search TIS for the appropriate service bulletin using the
current Calibration ID from the vehicle. Calibration file links can be found embedded
in the corresponding service bulletin.
S TIS Calibration Search
S TIS TSB Search
NOTE:
TIS searches can be performed by picking Division/Model/Year, current calibration ID,
or VDS code.
2. Connect the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station.
The GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station includes a Power Supply Mode that maintains
battery voltage at 13.5 volts during ECU reprogramming.
NOTE:
ECU damage may occur if the correct battery charger and mode setting are NOT used.
3. Locate appropriate calibration ID and reprogram the vehicle ECU with Techstream.
Techstream uses the Calibration Update Wizard (CUW) application to open calibration
files and facilitate the ECU flash reprogramming process.
4. Affix the Authorized Vehicle Modification Label.
Modifications to ECU calibrations MUST be recorded and properly displayed on the
vehicle using the Authorized Modification Label.
Page 3 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
April 26, 2007
The following steps describe how to properly flash reprogram an ECU using the
Techstream diagnostic application.
NOTE:
Ensure Techstream has been updated with the latest version of software.
1. Verify the vehicle’s applicability for recalibration and locate desired calibration file.
A. ECU Reprogram Method:
a. Establish a vehicle connection.
b. Click the ECU Reprogramming button on the System Select tab (Figure 1).
Figure 1
Page 4 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
c. Select available ECU(s) from the Calibration Update Check List (Figure 2).
NOTE:
Multiple ECUs can be selected.
d. Click the green arrow button (bottom right of screen) to retrieve current
calibration ID(s) and check for available calibration updates.
Figure 2
Page 5 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
e. Available calibration updates are indicated by a Yes in the Calibration Update
column (Figure 3). Click the Yes link to access the appropriate service bulletin
on TIS.
NOTE:
S Prior to flash reprogramming, check applicable systems for DTCs and note any DTCs.
S Clicking the Yes link will automatically launch TIS and perform a calibration search.
Figure 3
Page 6 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
f. Log in to TIS. (If already logged in, skip this step.)
g. To access the calibration file, click the service bulletin link in the Document
Title column of the Calibration Search Result portlet (Figure 4).
NOTE:
Only Toyota Certified Technicians and above may access calibration files.
Figure 4
Page 7 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
B. Health Check Method.
a. Establish a vehicle connection.
b. Click the Health Check button on the System Select tab (Figure 5).
Figure 5
Page 8 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
c. Choose desired ECU group(s) in the Health Check dialog box (Figure 6).
d. Click Next.
Figure 6
e. Click Continue to view Health Check results (Figure 7).
Figure 7
Page 9 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
f. Available calibration updates are indicated by a Yes link in the Cal. Update?
column. Click the Yes link to access the appropriate service bulletin on TIS
(Figure 8).
NOTE:
S Note any DTCs stored in systems that will be flash reprogrammed.
S Clicking the Yes link will automatically launch TIS and perform a calibration search.
Figure 8
g. Log in to TIS. (If already logged in, skip this step.)
Page 10 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
h. To review the TSB and access the calibration file, click the service bulletin link
in the Document Title column of the Calibration Search Result portlet.
NOTE:
Only Toyota Certified Technicians and above may access calibration files.
Figure 9
Page 11 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
2. Connect the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station.
A. Connect the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station to the car and turn it on.
B. Select Power Supply Mode by following the screen flow below (Figure 10).
NOTE:
S ECU damage may occur if the correct battery charger and mode setting are
NOT used.
S Power Supply Mode is used to maintain battery voltage at 13.5 volts while flash
reprogramming the vehicle.
S For details on how to use the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station, please refer to the
GR8 Instructions Manual, located on TIS, Diagnostics – Battery.
Figure 10
Confirm Power Supply
Mode is Selected
Page 12 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
3. Click the appropriate calibration ID (Figure 11) and reprogram the vehicle’s ECU
with Techstream.
A. After reviewing the procedures outlined in the selected TSB, click the appropriate
calibration ID link by matching the vehicle’s current calibration ID to the Previous
Calibration ID in the Calibration Identification Chart.
NOTE:
S Calibration files are embedded as live links in the service bulletin.
S Some vehicles require special preparation — please review the selected
TSB carefully.
Figure 11
Page 13 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
B. Click Open to load calibration file information (Figure 12).
NOTE:
Techstream pulls calibration files as needed to ensure the latest calibration file is used.
Do NOT save calibrations locally on the hard drive or other media.
Figure 12
Page 14 of 23
April 26, 2007
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
NOTE:
Errors during the flash reprogramming process can permanently damage the vehicle
ECU. Minimize the risk by following the steps below.
S Battery voltage MUST NOT FALL BELOW 11.4 volts during reprogramming.
Confirm battery voltage is higher than 11.4 volts, but be sure voltage DOES NOT
RISE ABOVE 16.0 volts during reprogramming.
S Turn OFF all vehicle accessories (e.g. audio system, A/C, interior lights, DRL, etc.).
Do NOT add to or significantly change the vehicle’s electrical load
while reprogramming.
S Confirm the hood is open and ensure under hood temperature does NOT exceed
158°F (70°C).
S Confirm cable connections between the vehicle and Techstream are secure.
S Do NOT disconnect or turn off Techstream or vehicle ignition during reprogramming.
S Set parking brake.
S Complete ALL flash calibration updates provided for each ECU.
S If the battery’s state of charge or capacity are in question, test with SST. No.
00002–V8150–KIT “Digital Battery Analyzer,” and follow TSB No. PG001–06,
“Battery Maintenance for In–Stock Vehicles & Pre–Delivery”.
S The GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station MUST be used in Power Supply Mode to
maintain battery voltage at 13.5 volts while flash reprogramming the vehicle.
For details on how to use the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station, please refer to the
GR8 Instructions Manual, located on TIS, Diagnostics – Battery.
C. Click Next to start the calibration update process.
Figure 13
Page 15 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
D. Select Techstream VIM as the desired programming device. Then click Next.
Figure 14
E. Confirm the following:
S PC is connected to VIM.
S VIM is connected to DLC3 connector.
S Ignition is ON and engine is OFF or “READY” OFF (hybrid vehicles).
Figure 15
Page 16 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
F. Verify correct current calibration and new calibration information.
NOTE:
S The total number of calibration IDs in the calibration file corresponds to the number
of reprogrammable processors in the ECU.
S Each calibration file may contain up to three separate calibrations.
S Figure 16 shows an example of the update procedure for a two–processor ECU.
Figure 16
G. Turn ignition OFF.
Figure 17
Page 17 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
H. Confirm the following:
S Ignition is ON and engine is OFF or “READY” OFF (hybrid vehicles).
S Hood is open.
S All accessories are OFF.
S Battery voltage is above 11.4 volts.
NOTE:
Verify the vehicle is connected to a battery charger before continuing — If battery
voltage falls below 11.4 volts, ECU damage may occur.
Figure 18
NOTE:
If key cycle is NOT done properly, reprogramming will stop at 10% and Cal 1 will fail
to load.
Page 18 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
I.
April 26, 2007
Do NOT disturb the vehicle during flash reprogramming.
NOTE:
S ECU flash reprogramming may take anywhere from 3 – 30 minutes per
calibration file.
S Reprogramming time will vary depending on model and ECU communication
protocol. Vehicles using CAN communication protocol will reprogram much faster
(2 – 7 minutes).
Figure 19
NOTE:
S If vehicle requires only ONE calibration update, then proceed to step N in this bulletin.
S If vehicle requires a SECOND calibration update, then continue as follows:
S For serial communication vehicles, go to step J.
S For CAN communication vehicles, go to step L.
Page 19 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
J. Cal 1 has completed the update process.
S Turn ignition OFF for a minimum of 10 seconds.
S Confirm ignition is returned to the ON position.
Figure 20
K. Confirm ignition is ON.
Figure 21
NOTE:
If key cycle is NOT done properly, reprogramming will stop at 10% and Cal 1 will fail
to load.
Page 20 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
L. Do NOT disturb the vehicle during flash reprogramming.
Figure 22
M. Turn ignition OFF for a minimum of 10 seconds. Then confirm ignition is returned
to the ON position.
Figure 23
Page 21 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
N. Confirm ignition is ON.
Figure 24
O. Confirm all calibrations were updated as specified in the service bulletin.
Figure 25
NOTE:
Some DTCs may have been set during the reprogramming process. Clear all DTCs
after restoring vehicle.
Page 22 of 23
TECHSTREAM ECU FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE – SS002-07
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 26, 2007
4. Affix Authorized Modification Label.
A. Using a permanent marker or ball point pen, complete the Authorized
Modifications Label and attach to the vehicle (Figure 26). The Authorized
Modifications Label is available through the MDC, P/N 00451–00001–LBL.
Figure 26. SAMPLE OF COMPLETED AUTHORIZED MODIFICATIONS LABEL
Replacement
ECU Part Number
Calibration ID(s)
Dealer Code
THE FOLLOWING MODIFICATIONS HAVE BEEN MADE:
89661–08120
30806000, 50805000
THESE MODIFICATIONS HAVE BEEN APPROVED
AS APPROPRIATE BY EPA AND CARB
DEALER CODE: 31301
DATE: 8/2/06
CHANGE AUTHORITY: TSB TC007–03
Date Completed
TSB or Campaign Number
B. Attach the label under the hood in the location determined by the specific vehicle
TSB or Campaign.
NOTE:
Wait 60 – 90 seconds for ink to set before handling.
Page 23 of 23
Technical Service
BULLETIN
November 16, 2001
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT:
VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE
Models:
All ’02 – ’07 Toyota & ’04 – ’07 Scion Models
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S March 21, 2007: The OP Code for “Preliminary Check & Road Test” and the note have
been updated in Warranty Information.
S April 4, 2006: 2007 model year has been added to Applicable Vehicles.
S October 21, 2005: 2003 – 2006 model years for Toyota models and 2004 – 2006 model
years for Scion models have been added to Applicable Vehicles. A note has been
added to the illustration in Repair Procedure 3.
S March 1, 2004: The note in Step 2-A of the “Wheel Alignment & Tire Characteristics”
Section has been changed.
S December 21, 2001: OP Codes updated in Warranty Information.
All previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
This bulletin contains general vehicle pulling diagnosis and repair procedures along with
specific information to help correct pulling complaints.
This information supplements Repair Manual procedures when the symptoms are:
S The driver holds the steering wheel without exerting steering effort while driving
straight ahead, the vehicle drifts to the right or the left.
S While driving straight ahead, the driver has to steer either to the right or the left to
maintain straight driving.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2002 – 2007 model year Toyota vehicles.
S 2004 – 2007 model year Scion vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
044184
Combo A
Combo B
Combo C
Combo D
Combo E
Preliminary Check & Road Test
Switch Front Tire/Wheel & Road Test
Reverse the Front One Side Tire
Check Front Wheel Alignment
Adjust Front Wheel Alignment
Adjust Camber Setting
Dismount and Mount Tire and Balance Wheel
and Tire Assembly
Each additional Wheel
0.6
0.5
0.7
1.2
0.7
0.7
45046 09020
45046–09020
420091
Combo A
0.5
T1
T2
31 99
42611–08010
0.3
NOTE:
OP Code 044184 and the above combination codes apply to all models with the
EXCEPTION of Combo E for MR2 model.
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 12 months or 20,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 11
STEERING
ST005-01
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Contents
November 16, 2001
This bulletin is divided into the following sections:
Wheel Alignment and Tire Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 3–4
Repair Procedure Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 5
Repair Procedures
1. Important Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 6
2. Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 6–7
3. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 7–8
4. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Tire Conicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 8–10
5. Camber Adjustment Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 10–11
Page 2 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Wheel
Alignment &
Tire
Characteristics
November 16, 2001
1. Relationship Between Wheel Alignment and Vehicle Pulling to One Side
When the cross camber or caster of the front wheel alignment is large, it can cause
vehicle pulling.
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
DIRECTION OF VEHICLE PULLING
Camber
Vehicle pulls in direction of wheel with large camber value
Caster
Vehicle pulls in direction of wheel with small caster value
CAMBER
Straight-Ahead
Driving
CASTER
Direction of Pull
Front
P’
T’
P
T
a’
a
Caster Trail
(Large)
Caster Trail
(Small)
O
F
O’
F’
P, P’: Driving Force
a, a’: Steering Axes
O, O’: Center of Tire-Road
Contact Area
F, F’: Reactive Force
If the cross camber or caster is within the specified range (30’ or less), noticeable vehicle
pulling will not occur due to side-to-side differences in camber or caster.
NOTE:
On a flat road, if the cross camber or caster is 30’ or less and the steering wheel is
held without exerting steering effort for 100 m (109 yards) when driving at 100 km/h
(62 mph), the alignment-induced drift distance is approximately 0.5 m (1.64 ft).
Page 3 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Wheel
Alignment &
Tire
Characteristics
(Continued)
November 16, 2001
2. Relationship Between Tire Characteristics and Vehicle Pulling to One Side
When radial tires are rotating, they have the characteristic of generating force in the
lateral direction between the tire and the road surface. This lateral force is comprised
of two factors:
S Ply-steer, which changes direction according to the rotation direction of the tires.
S Conicity, which is generated in a fixed direction regardless of the tire rotation
direction.
If these lateral forces are too strong, vehicle pulling will occur.
A. Ply-Steer
Lateral force due to ply-steer is produced by the construction of the belts inside
the tire tread. With radial tires, the wire of the belt is slanted as shown in the
illustration below. Thus, it is in the lateral direction that tire tread easily changes
shape (stretches), and lateral force is generated between the tire and the road
surface in the lateral direction.
Rotation Direction
Easily-Stretched
Direction
Wire
Ply–Steer
(Direction of Force Generation Varies
According to Tire Rotation)
Belt
NOTE:
Lateral force from ply-steer prevents vehicle drift caused by road slant, so in many
cases lateral force to the left is provided to compensate for road slant to the right.
B. Conicity
Conicity is lateral force resulting from uneven formation of the left and right sides
of the tire. The direction the lateral force is exerted depends on the hardness of
the side walls and the difference in height between the left/right sides of the tire.
Hard
Part
Conicity
(Direction Is Fixed Regardless of
Direction of Tire Rotation)
NOTE:
S In the case of vehicle pulling caused by tires, the lateral force which is exerted as a
result of conicity has the greatest effect. On a flat road, if the steering wheel is held
without exerting steering effort for 100 m (109 yards) when travelling at 100 km/h (62
mph), the vehicle may drift as much as 1.5 m (5 ft).
S When vehicle pulling is due to conicity, the amount of drift can be reduced and the
direction of drift can be changed by changing the location of the tire or reversing
the tire when installing it on the wheel.
Page 4 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedure
Flow Chart
November 16, 2001
START
Preliminary Check
S Tire Pressure
S Vehicle height
S Brake Dragging
NO Is there steering
off center?
*ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle lead/pull?
YES
NO
COMPLETE
YES
Adjust front tie rods.
See TSB ST003-01
YES
Are the tires uni–directional type?
NO
NO
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
Cross switch front tire and wheel
assemblies (left & right)
YES
Choose the position of front tire & wheel
assemblies where there is least amount of pull.
YES
Does the vehicle lead/pull in the
same direction as before?
NO
YES
Check front wheel alignment.
Is it within specification?
NO
Is the lead/pull stronger
than before?
NO
YES
Reverse the front left side
tire and rebalance it.
Adjust front wheel alignment.
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
NO
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
YES
YES
Does the vehicle
lead/pull to the left?
COMPLETE
YES
NO
Increase right front camber and decrease left
front camber until lead/pull is eliminated.
NO
NO
NOTE: Do not exceed 1_ of
cross camber.
Do not exceed adjustment range.
Increase left front camber and decrease right
front camber until lead/pull is eliminated.
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
YES
Contact your regional office.
* Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line for 100 meters at a constant speed of
35 mph. Please confirm safety and set the steering wheel to its straight position. Drive the vehicle in a
straight line for 100 meters at a constant speed of 35 mph without exerting steering effort on the steering
wheel.
(1) The vehicle goes straight but the steering wheel has some angle.
(2) The vehicle does not go straight.
STEERING OFF CENTER
STEERING PULL
Page 5 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedures
November 16, 2001
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE
Before repairing vehicle pulling to one side, it is necessary to clearly identify the
cause of the pulling condition. Frequently, the cause of the vehicle pulling to one side
is diagnosed as wheel alignment. However, the actual cause may be lateral force
generated by the tires. Performing wheel alignment when tire force is the cause could
result in the wheel alignment being set at a value outside of specifications. This would
then cause other problems such as uneven tire wear, etc.
2. Troubleshooting
First determine whether vehicle pulling to one side is caused by a wheel alignment
problem or tire characteristics, then decide which repairs to make.
A. Perform the following checks and correct as necessary.
a. Check tires for size, wear and for proper inflation pressure.
b. Check whether the vehicle is noticeably tilted backward/forward or left/right.
NOTE:
Tilting of the vehicle produces a left-right difference in the camber and caster and can
cause vehicle pulling to one side.
c. Check brakes for dragging.
B. Confirm problem symptoms.
With the customer accompanying you, drive the vehicle to confirm if the
customer’s complaint involves vehicle pulling to one side or steering wheel off
center. If the problem is steering wheel off center, adjust the front tie rods on the
vehicle. Refer to Toyota TSB ST003-01. Also check the direction of vehicle
pulling and the extent of the pulling.
C. Decide if vehicle pulling is due to wheel alignment or tires.
a. Switch the left and right front tires (If the tires are non-unidirectional).
b. Conduct a drive test to check whether the direction that the vehicle pulls
has changed.
Page 6 of 11
SYMPTOM
PROBABLE CAUSE
CORRECTIVE ACTION
No change in vehicle
pulling condition
Front wheel alignment
Proceed to Repair Procedure 3. Vehicle pulling
caused by Wheel Alignment (Page 6)
Vehicle pulling
eliminated
Tire conicity
Repair complete. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Tire
Conicity (Page 3 and 6)
Vehicle pulling
direction is reversed
Tire conicity
Proceed to Repair Procedure 4. Vehicle Pulling
Caused by Tire Conicity (Page 7)
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
November 16, 2001
Helpful hints to determine cause of vehicle pulling:
S The direction of lateral force from tire conicity becomes reversed when the left and
right tires are switched. Therefore, if the pulling direction changes when the tires are
switched, it can be concluded that vehicle pulling is caused by tire conicity.
ORIGINAL TIRE POSITIONS
Vehicle Pulling
Direction (Right)
TIRES SWITCHED
Lateral Force by
Conicity
The Vehicle is Pulled to the Right by
the Lateral Force Exerted to the Right.
Vehicle Pulling
Direction (Left)
Lateral Force by
Conicity
The Direction of the Tires Which Exerted Lateral
Force to the Right has Been Changed, so the Tires
Now Exert Lateral Force to the Left and the Vehicle
Now Pulls to the Left.
S If the pulling direction does not change after the front tires are switched, the cause of
vehicle pulling is not tire conicity. In this case, the likely cause is a front wheel
alignment condition.
3. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Wheel Alignment
When it is determined by troubleshooting that the vehicle pulling to one side is
caused by wheel alignment, perform repairs according to the following procedure.
Vehicle Pulling to One Side
Check Front Wheel Alignment
Not Within Specification
Within Specification
Adjust Front Wheel Alignment
Road Test
OK
Within Specification But
Vehicle Pulls
Vehicle Still Pulls
Adjust Cross Camber to Eliminate Vehicle Pulling
NOTE: Do not exceed 1_ of cross camber.
Page 7 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
November 16, 2001
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO LEFT
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO RIGHT
Increase right front camber and decrease left
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
Increase left front camber and decrease right
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
NOTE:
S Keep the cross camber within 1_ or less.
S Keep the camber of each wheel within specifications (+/–45’ of center value).
S If adjustment exceeds the specifications, uneven tire wear will result.
4. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Tire Conicity
When it is determined by troubleshooting that the vehicle pulling to one side is
caused by tire conicity, perform repairs according to the following procedures.
Indication of Tire Conicity as a Cause:
When the front tires are switched, the pulling direction changes. Proceed to STEP 1.
STEP 1:
Remove the front left tire from the wheel and reverse the tire. Then perform a road
test and check for change in the pulling direction.
HINT:
By performing this operation, it can be checked whether the left or right tire exerts a
stronger lateral force. Either tire can be reversed. Shown here is an example of the left
tire reversed.
If Vehicle Pulls in the Same Direction: Go to STEP 2.
The lateral force generated by the right front tire is greater than the left tire, so
the vehicle is pulling due to the lateral force of the right tire.
ORIGINAL TIRE POSITIONS
Vehicle Pulling
Direction
LEFT TIRE REVERSE INSTALLATION
Vehicle Pulling Direction
(Same Direction)
Reversed
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
Page 8 of 11
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
November 16, 2001
If Vehicle Pulls in the Opposite Direction: Go to STEP 2.
The lateral force generated by the left front tire is greater than the right tire, so
the vehicle is pulling due to the lateral force of the left tire.
ORIGINAL TIRE POSITIONS
LEFT TIRE REVERSE INSTALLATION
Vehicle Pulling
Direction
Vehicle Pulling
Direction
(Opposite Direction)
Reversed
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
If Vehicle Pull Is Eliminated: Repair Is Now Complete.
The lateral force generated by the left and right front tires is virtually the same, so the
lateral force is neutralized and the vehicle travels straight ahead. The repair operation
is now completed.
STEP 2:
Rotate the larger lateral force front tire with the rear tire and check the change in the
vehicle pulling.
NOTE:
By shifting the front tire with the larger lateral force to the rear, the vehicle pulling
level is usually reduced.
If Vehicle Is Still Pulling: Go to STEP 3.
If Vehicle Pull Is Eliminated: Repair Is Now Complete.
Page 9 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
November 16, 2001
STEP 3:
Adjust cross camber to eliminate vehicle pulling.
HINT:
If the tires are placed in the positions they were in during tire rotation when the least
amount of vehicle pulling occurred, wheel alignment can be performed with a minimal
amount of adjustment.
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO LEFT
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO RIGHT
Increase right front camber and decrease left
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
Increase left front camber and decrease right
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
NOTE:
S Keep the cross camber within 1_ or less.
S Keep the camber of each wheel within specifications (+/–45’ of center value).
S If adjustment exceeds the specifications, uneven tire wear will result.
5. Camber Adjustment Method
NOTE:
After the camber has been adjusted,
inspect the toe-in.
NOTE:
The method of camber adjustment
differs for different models, so please
refer to the repair manual of the
vehicle involved. (This is a sample
from the Sienna Repair Manual).
A. Remove the front wheels and
ABS speed sensor clamp.
B. Remove the two nuts on the lower
side of the shock absorber.
C. Coat the threads of the nuts with
engine oil.
D. Temporarily install the two nuts.
E. Adjust the camber by pushing
or pulling the lower side of the
shock absorber in the direction
in which the camber adjustment
is required.
F. Tighten the nuts.
Torque: 210 NSm
(2,150 kgfScm, 155 ftSlbf)
Page 10 of 11
1
2
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – ST005-01 Revised
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
November 16, 2001
G. Install the front wheels.
Torque: 104 NSm (1,050 kgfScm, 77 ftSlbf)
H. Check the camber.
NOTE:
Adjusting value for the set bolts is
6’ – 30’ (0.1_ – 0.5_).
When making an adjustment of more
than 45’, replace the upper and lower
steering knuckle set bolts with the
adjusting bolts. If the camber is NOT
within the specification, use the table
shown to estimate how much
additional camber adjustment will be
required, and select the appropriate
camber adjusting bolt.
I.
Follow steps 5-a through 5-h
again. Between steps 5-b and
5-c, exchange one or two
selected bolts.
HINT:
When exchanging the two bolts,
exchange one bolt each time.
If Vehicle Pull Is Eliminated: Repair Is Now Complete.
If Vehicle Is Still Pulling: Contact Your Regional Office for Further Assistance.
Page 11 of 11
Technical Service
BULLETIN
October 24, 2006
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
SHOCK ABSORBER
REPLACEMENT CRITERIA
Models:
’06 – ’07 Toyota
The purpose of this TSB is to provide a quick reference to assist in making easy
judgements regarding shock absorber and strut replacements.
S 2006 – 2007 model year Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
SUSPENSION
SU007-06
Title:
SHOCK ABSORBER REPLACEMENT CRITERIA – SU007-06
Inspection
October 24, 2006
Strut Type:
LEVEL 5
LEVEL 4
LEVEL 3
LEVEL 2
LEVEL 1
Oil leak,
covering top,
spring seat,
and part of
strut body
Oil leak,
covering entire
strut body,
spring seat,
and knuckle
bracket
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Oil Seal
Case
OIL LEAK
CRITERIA
Spring
Seat
Knuckle
Bracket
Page 2 of 4
CONDITION
Slight oil
seepage from oil
seal case
Moderate oil
seepage from
oil seal case
Oil leak/drip
on the seal
case,
extending
below the
spring seat
ACTION
Normal oil
evaporation —
NOT necessary
to replace the
shock absorber
Normal oil
evaporation
— NOT
necessary to
replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
SHOCK ABSORBER REPLACEMENT CRITERIA – SU007-06
Inspection
(Continued)
October 24, 2006
Shock Absorber Type with Spring Seat:
LEVEL 5
LEVEL 4
Oil
Seal
Case
LEVEL 3
LEVEL 2
LEVEL 1
Oil leak,
covering top,
spring seat,
and part of
shock body
Oil leak,
covering entire
shock body
and spring
seat, and
extending to
lower bushing
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
1/3 L
OIL LEAK
CRITERIA
L
Lower
Bushing
Lower
Bracket
CONDITION
Slight oil
seepage from oil
seal case
Moderate oil
seepage from
oil seal case
Oil leak/drip
on the seal
case,
extending
below the
spring seat
ACTION
Normal oil
evaporation —
NOT necessary
to replace the
shock absorber
Normal oil
evaporation
— NOT
necessary to
replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Page 3 of 4
SHOCK ABSORBER REPLACEMENT CRITERIA – SU007-06
Inspection
(Continued)
October 24, 2006
Shock Absorber Type:
LEVEL 5
LEVEL 4
LEVEL 3
LEVEL 2
LEVEL 1
OIL LEAK
CRITERIA
L
1/3 L
L
1/2 L
Page 4 of 4
CONDITION
Slight oil
seepage,
covering
approximately
1/4 of outer tube
Moderate oil
seepage,
covering
approximately
1/3 of outer
tube
Oil leak/drip
down outer
tube
Oil leak,
covering 1/2 of
outer tube
Oil leak,
covering entire
shock body
and extending
to lower
bushing
ACTION
Normal oil
evaporation —
NOT necessary
to replace the
shock absorber
Normal oil
evaporation
— NOT
necessary to
replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Abnormal oil
leak —
Replace the
shock
absorber
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 13, 2007
INITIAL CALIBRATION OF COMPASS
DURING PDS
Models:
’08 4Runner
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S August 17, 2007: The zone reference illustration in step 2 has been updated.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Some 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles are equipped with a compass in the rear view
mirror. Use the following procedure to complete initial calibration of the compass during
Pre-Delivery Service (PDS).
Compass Display
“Multifunction” Switch
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD059-07
Title:
INITIAL CALIBRATION OF COMPASS DURING PDS – PD059-07 Revised
Compass
Calibration
Procedure
June 13, 2007
1. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON”
position and push and hold the switch
for 6 seconds until the zone number
appears on the compass display.
2. Push the switch to select the
number of the zone where the
vehicle is located.
See the map below for
zone reference.
A. Samoa:
Guam:
Saipan:
North America
1
15
2
14
3
13
4
12
5
8
6
7
Page 2 of 3
9
10
11
5
8
8
INITIAL CALIBRATION OF COMPASS DURING PDS – PD059-07 Revised
Compass
Calibration
Procedure
(Continued)
June 13, 2007
3. Start the engine and push and hold
the switch for about 9 seconds until
“C” appears on the display.
4. Drive the vehicle slowly at 5 mph
(8 km/h), or less, in a circle until the
direction is displayed. If there is NOT
enough space to drive in a circle, turn
the car around as shown, doing two
three-point turns in succession.
After driving in 1 to 3 circles in the
above method, calibration is complete
with the direction shown on
the display.
NOTE:
S Do NOT perform calibration of the
compass in a place where the
Earth’s magnetic field is subject to
interference (underground parking,
under a steel tower, between
buildings, roof parking, near a
railroad crossing, near a large
vehicle, etc.)
S During calibration, do NOT operate
electric systems (moon roof, power
windows, etc.) as they may interfere
with the calibration.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 13, 2007
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
SHORT PIN INSTALLATION
DURING PDS
Models:
’08 4Runner
To minimize battery discharge during transportation and storage, the Short Pin has been
removed at the assembly plant and temporarily stored in the engine compartment Relay
Block. Reinstall the Short Pin into its original location and confirm all related DTCs are
cleared during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS).
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
Required
Tools &
Equipment
REQUIRED EQUIPMENT
SUPPLIER
PART NUMBER
QTY
ADE
TSPKG1
1
TIS Techstream*
NOTE: Software version 2.00.008
or later is required.
*
Essential SST.
NOTE:
S Additional Techstream units may be ordered by calling Approved Dealer
Equipment (ADE) at 1–800–368–6787.
S The Toyota Diagnostic Tester and CAN Interface Module may also be used to
perform the service procedures listed in this bulletin.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD060-07
Title:
SHORT PIN INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD060-07
Installation
Procedure
The Short Pin is stored in the
blank space of the Relay Block in the
engine compartment.
June 13, 2007
Engine Compartment
Relay Block
During Pre-Delivery Service (PDS),
install the Short Pin in the Relay Block
as shown.
Relay Block
NOTE:
S Removing the Short Pin cuts off
power sources relating to the
DOME, RADIO No. 1, and
ECU-B fuses.
S The Short Pin does not function as
a fuse, so install it only in the
position shown.
S If the vehicle is stored in the
dealership for a long period of
time after PDS, disconnect the
negative (–) battery terminal to
prevent battery discharge. Refer to
TSB No. PG001-06, “Battery
Maintenance for In-Stock Vehicles &
Pre-Delivery,” for battery
maintenance information.
DTC Clearing
Procedure
Install Short Pin Here
(Original Location)
Remove This
Short Pin
With the Short Pin removed, the occupant classification ECU and Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly (airbag ECU) may detect the interruption in battery voltage (B+) and store a
DTC. Clear DTC B1150 and B1794 after installing the Short Pin.
1. Connect TIS Techstream to the DLC3.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the “IG-ON” position.
3. Using TIS Techstream, check any other codes being output.
HINT:
If any DTCs besides DTC B1150 and B1794 remain, repair the applicable system
according to the Repair Manual.
4. Erase DTCs (B1150 and B1794) and Freeze Frame Data.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 13, 2007
Introduction
INITIALIZATION OF BACK DOOR
POWER WINDOW DURING PDS
Models:
’08 4Runner
This bulletin outlines the initialization procedure for the back door power window on
the 4Runner.
To minimize the battery discharge during transportation and storage, the Short Pin has
been removed at the assembly plant, resulting in the following feature being inoperative:
S One-touch open and close with jam protection.
Use the following initialization procedure after installing the Short Pin during Pre-Delivery
Service (PDS) and whenever the battery has been disconnected.
NOTE:
Any time the battery terminal has been disconnected, the back door power window
MUST be re-initialized.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Initialization
Procedure
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Make sure the Short Pin is installed
in its original location. (Refer to TSB
No. PD060-07, “Short Pin Installation
During PDS.”)
Short Pin Original Location
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD061-07
Title:
INITIALIZATION OF BACK DOOR POWER WINDOW DURING PDS – PD061-07
Initialization
Procedure
(Continued)
June 13, 2007
1. Turn ignition switch to the
“ON” position.
2. Push the back door power window
switch to the “DOWN” side to open
the window.
3. Push and hold the back door power
window switch to the “UP” side until
the window closes. Continue holding it
for approximately 1 second.
4. Check for proper operation of the
“one-touch open/close” functions by
pushing the switch briefly to the
“DOWN” and “UP” positions.
NOTE:
Jam protection function becomes
effective through the above
initialization procedure.
Page 2 of 2
Completely Closed
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 13, 2007
Introduction
DRIVER'S DOOR POWER WINDOW &
MOON ROOF INITIALIZATION
Models:
’08 4Runner
This bulletin outlines the initialization procedure for the driver’s door power window and
the moon roof on 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
If the battery has been disconnected, the ECU will not be able to detect and memorize
the driver’s door power window and moon roof positions, resulting in the following
features being inoperative:
S One-touch open and close of driver’s door power window with jam protection.
S One-touch slide open and close of moon roof with jam protection.
S One-touch tilt up and down of moon roof with jam protection.
Use the following initialization procedure during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS) and
whenever the battery has been disconnected.
NOTE:
Any time the battery terminal has been disconnected, the driver’s door power window
and moon roof MUST be re-initialized.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Initialization
Procedure
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Driver’s Door Power Window
1. Turn the ignition to the “ON” position.
NOTE:
At this time, the power switch for
the driver’s door window should
be blinking.
2. Push down and hold the driver’s door
power window switch to completely
open the window.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Power Window Switch
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD062-07
Title:
DRIVER’S DOOR POWER WINDOW & MOON ROOF INITIALIZATION – PD062-07
Initialization
Procedure
(Continued)
3. Pull and hold up the driver’s door
power window switch until the window
closes. Continue holding the switch
for approximately one second until the
switch changes from blinking to a
constant illumination.
June 13, 2007
Completely Closed
4. Check for proper operation of the
“one-touch open/close” by pushing
the switch briefly to the “DOWN” and
“UP” positions.
NOTE:
Jam protection function becomes
effective through the above
initialization procedure.
TROUBLESHOOTING:
If power window is unable to close after initialization, perform the
following procedure.
NOTE:
If the power window switch is continuously operated for a long time, the power
window motor will stop to prevent additional load on the motor. Continuing to press
the power window switch even after the motor has stopped will cause the switch to
blink and will restrict the AUTO UP/DOWN function and remote UP/DOWN function.
If this happens, wait for a few minutes before attempting to reset the motor again.
1. Disconnect the negative (–) battery terminal. After 10 seconds, reconnect the
battery terminal.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. Halfway close the door glass by
pressing the switch. Then fully pull up on the switch until the door glass is fully
closed, and continue holding the switch for approximately one second after the
door glass is fully closed.
" Check for proper operation of the AUTO UP/DOWN function.
3. If the power window motor is still unable to close:
Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. Halfway close the door glass by
pressing the switch. Then fully pull up on the switch until the door glass is fully
closed, and continue holding the switch for approximately 12 seconds after the
door glass is fully closed.
" Check for proper operation of the AUTO UP/DOWN function.
Page 2 of 3
DRIVER’S DOOR POWER WINDOW & MOON ROOF INITIALIZATION – PD062-07
Initialization
Procedure
(Continued)
June 13, 2007
Moon Roof
1. Turn the ignition to the “ON” position.
2. Push and hold the “TILT UP” side of the
switch until the moon roof tilts all the way
up and then tilts down slightly
(approximately 10 mm [0.39 in.] at
the rear).
3. Check for proper operation of the
“one-touch slide open/close” and
“one-touch tilt up/down” functions
by pushing the switch briefly to
the “SLIDE OPEN” and
“TILT UP” positions.
Approx. 10 mm
NOTE:
Jam protection function becomes
effective through the above
initialization procedure.
Page 3 of 3
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
VALVE/SENSOR ACTIVATION
Models:
’08 4Runner
June 18, 2007
Introduction
2008 model year 4Runner vehicles are equipped with a direct-type Tire Pressure
Warning System (TPWS). Each tire (including the spare tire) has a tire pressure warning
valve/sensor, and the measured tire pressure data is transmitted to the Tire Pressure
Warning System antenna/receiver to the Tire Pressure Warning System ECU.
During Pre-Delivery Service (PDS), the tire pressure warning valves/sensors must be
activated according to the procedure in this bulletin.
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Equipment
REQUIRED EQUIPMENT
SUPPLIER
PART NUMBER
QTY
ADE
TSPKG1
1
TIS Techstream*
NOTE: Software version 2.00.008
or later is required.
*
Essential SST.
NOTE:
S Additional Techstream units may be ordered by calling Approved Dealer
Equipment (ADE) at 1–800–368–6787.
S The Toyota Diagnostic Tester and CAN Interface Module may also be used to
perform the service procedures listed in this bulletin.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
PD064-07
Title:
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE/SENSOR ACTIVATION – PD064-07
Reference
June 18, 2007
S The Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
will blink until all the tire pressure
warning valves/sensors are activated.
S The Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
listed below may be stored in the
TPWS ECU until the tire pressure
warning valves/sensors are activated.
S The DTCs will automatically clear
when the tire pressure warning
valves/sensors are activated.
*1:
*2:
Activation
Procedure
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
DTC NO. *1
DTC NO. *2
DTC EXPLANATION
11
C2111
Transmitter ID1 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
12
C2112
Transmitter ID2 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
13
C2113
Transmitter ID3 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
14
C2114
Transmitter ID4 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
15
C2115
Transmitter ID5 Operation Stop (sleep mode)
DTC No. indicated by blinking of the Low Tire Pressure Warning Light.
DTC No. indicated on TIS Techstream.
1. Connect TIS Techstream.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the “ON”
position and check that the Low Tire
Pressure Warning Light blinks.
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Page 2 of 3
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE/SENSOR ACTIVATION – PD064-07
Activation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 18, 2007
3. Press or remove the valve core to
reduce the tire inflation pressure
rapidly by 6 psi (0.4 kgf/cm2, 40 kPa),
or more, within 30 seconds.
Core
If the tire inflation pressure is NOT
reduced by 6 psi (0.4 kgf/cm2,
40 kPa), or more, within 30 seconds,
the tire pressure warning
valves/sensors will NOT be activated.
NOTE:
This operation is required for the
system to be activated and must be
performed for each tire (including the
spare tire), one at a time.
4. Using TIS Techstream, check for TPWS DTCs.
S If NO DTCs are stored, go to step 5.
S If DTCs C2111 – C2115 are stored, repeat step 3.
S If any other DTCs are stored, refer to the Repair Manual.
5. Adjust all tires (including the spare tire) to the standard tire inflation pressure and
confirm that the Low Tire Pressure Warning Light is OFF.
TIRE SIZE
TIRE PRESSURE (psi, kgf/cm2, kPa)
P265/70R16 111S
P265/65R17 110S
32 2.2,
32,
2 2 220
NOTE:
S If there is great difference between the current temperature of the tire and wheel
(for example: shop temperature) and expected temperature (for example: outdoor
temperature), this needs to be considered when adjusting the tire pressure.
S Adjust the tire pressure when the tires are cold.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 18, 2007
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Installation
Procedure
LICENSE PLATE INSTALLATION
DURING PDS
Models:
’08 4Runner
The following procedure is recommended for front and rear license plate installation on
2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Front License Plate
1. Align the holes on the license plate to
the dimples on the front bumper.
2. Install two (2) self-tapping screws
through the license plate and into the
front bumper at the dimples.
NOTE:
S Do NOT drill holes into the bumper.
S Do NOT overtighten the screws.
Dimples
Use non-corroding self-tapping screws
with the following dimensions:
Nominal Length: 16.5 mm (0.65 in.) –
20.0 mm (0.79 in.)
6.0 mm
(0.24 in.)
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.24 in.)
16.5 – 20.0 mm
(0.65 – 0.79 in.)
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD065-07
Title:
LICENSE PLATE INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD065-07
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 18, 2007
Rear License Plate
1. Align the installation holes on the rear license plate with the holes on the back door.
2. Install two (2) bolts through the license plate and into the holes (welded nuts) in the
back door.
Use non-corroding bolts with the following dimensions:
Nominal Length: 25.0 mm (0.98 in.) or shorter
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.24 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.04 in.)
NOTE:
If bolts longer than 25 mm (0.98 in.) are used, the back door window glass may be
damaged or broken.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 18, 2007
Introduction
ROOF RACK CROSS BAR
INSTALLATION DURING PDS
Models:
’08 4Runner
To prevent paint damage during transportation, the roof rack cross bars are kept inside
the vehicle so that the Rapgardt protective film can remain in place on the roof panel.
Install the roof rack cross bars to the roof rack rails according to the following procedure
during Pre-Delivery Service (PDS).
NOTE:
To prevent damage to the front and rear roof rack leg covers, install the cross bar
stoppers at each end of the right and left roof rack rails.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Installation
Procedure
S 2008 model year 4Runner vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
1. Loosen the adjustment knobs on each
cross bar joint.
NOTE:
Do NOT remove adjustment
knobs completely.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD066-07
Title:
ROOF RACK CROSS BAR INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD066-07
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 18, 2007
2. Slide the cross bar ends into the
grooves of the right and left roof rack
rails with the arrow on each cross bar
facing forward.
Front
NOTE:
The cross bars will create wind noise
at highway speeds if they are
installed backwards.
Arrow Mark
3. Align the ends of the front and rear
cross bars with the paint marks on the
roof rack as illustrated. Then securely
tighten the knobs.
Front
Paint Mark
NOTE:
Placing the cross bars at the paint
marks on the roof rack side rails
minimizes wind noise generated by the
cross bars.
4. Install the right and left rear roof rack
leg covers.
A
A. Insert the protrusion at the front of
the cover into the roof rack rail.
B. Place the cover on the leg,
aligning each rear end.
At this time, do NOT press
the cover down.
C. Engage the cover claws located
toward the outside of the vehicle.
D. Engage the cover claws located
toward the inside of the vehicle.
NOTE:
If the inside and outside cover claws
are pressed down at the same time, the
cover claws may be damaged.
E. Check that the cover is
installed securely.
Page 2 of 3
D
Outside
Rear
C
B
ROOF RACK CROSS BAR INSTALLATION DURING PDS – PD066-07
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
5. Install the cross bar stopper at the
front and rear ends of the right and
left roof rack rail.
June 18, 2007
Front
NOTE:
Cross bar stoppers are installed to
prevent damage caused by
interference between the cross bar and
the front and rear roof rack leg covers.
Cross Bar Stopper
Rear
Cross Bar Stopper
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 21, 2007
Introduction
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY
SERVICE (PDS)
Models:
’08 4Runner
Pre-Delivery Service is a critical step in satisfying your dealership’s new car customers.
Customer feedback indicates the following areas deserve special attention when
performing PDS:
S Careful inspection for paint chips/scratches and body dents/dings.
S Proper operation of electrical accessories (including interior light, clock, and
radio reset).
S Interior cleanliness.
S Proper function of mechanical systems.
Customer retention and proper maintenance of vehicles has been a major focus for
Toyota. To help remind customers that regular oil changes are essential to the proper
maintenance of their vehicle, dealers are required to begin installing a first oil change
reminder sticker prior to delivery. By doing this, customers will be reminded to return to
your dealership for their first oil change. Your current oil change reminder sticker may
be used. (See PDS Check Sheet item G09.)
A new PDS form has been developed for the 2008 model year 4Runner. Some check
points have been added, expanded, or clarified. TSBs are available for items in bold
red type.
Warranty
Policy
If the need for additional repairs or adjustment is noted during the Pre-Delivery Service,
the required service should be performed under warranty. Reimbursement will be
managed under the warranty policy.
The Warranty Policy and Procedures Manual requires that you maintain the
completed PDS check sheet in the customer’s file. If you cannot produce a completed
form for each retailed vehicle upon TMS and/or Region/Distributor audit, the PDS
payment amount will be subject to debit.
An additional Repair Order completed in conjunction with normal PDS must have time
punch/flags for service. If multiple repairs are performed, separate time flags must be
punched for each repair.
Reimbursement
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
001013
Pre-Delivery Service (PDS)
0.9
N/A
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
T1
T2
N/A N/A
Page 1 of 5
PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE
PD069-07
Title:
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
2008 Model
Year PDS
Check Sheet
Page 2 of 5
June 21, 2007
TOYOTA 4RUNNER
2008 PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE CHECK SHEET
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
June 21, 2007
Before
Inspection
When performing new car Pre-Delivery Service, install Short Pin before moving vehicle
from storage lot so that FUNCTIONAL OPERATION checks can begin as soon as vehicle
is moved into the service stall.
A01 Install Short Pin
A02 Initialize driver’s door power window
A03 Initialize moon roof*
A04 Initialize back door power window
Functional
Operation
Apply parking brake and turn ignition “ON,” place gear selector in reverse, turn on
lights and rear defogger. Unlock all doors, release fuel door, release back door.
B01 Check dome, courtesy, map, and sun visor lights*
B02 Check warning/indicator lights, gauges, and horn
B03 Check windshield wipers and washers
B04 Check headlights, instrument lights, turn signals, emergency flashers, and
brake lights
B05 Check inside/outside rear view mirror operation/adjustment
B06 Check cigarette lighter* and power outlets
Check the power outlets using an electrical accessory designed for this use.
B07 Check moon roof*
B08 Check audio/navigation*/backup camera* system and set clock*
For navigation, set the destination search area to local position.
B09 Check Rear Seat Entertainment System operation*
B10 Install shift-lock override button cover
Walkaround
Inspection
Starting at the left front door, check window and door lock operation and the operation
of all power windows and door locks from master power switch, on vehicles so equipped.
While walking around vehicle in a counterclockwise direction, open left rear door and
check operation of window regulator and door lock, set child safety door locks to the
normal (unlocked) position. Assure tightness of interior garnishes and check seat belts.
Inspect luggage compartment contents and lights at rear of vehicle. Repeat checks at
right rear door. Inspect right front door window regulator and lock operation and
garnishes. Check seat and seat belt operation. Continue on around to the front of the
vehicle checking lights.
C01 Check window operation
C02 Check door and door lock operation, including wireless remote control/theft
deterrent system*
C03 Check that engine starts with all keys
C04 Check that child safety door locks are in normal (unlocked) position
C05 Check seats and seat belt operation
C06 Check rear defogger
C07 Check side marker, tail, backup, and license plate lights
C08 Check luggage compartment light* and trim appearance
C09 Adjust spare tire pressure and check jack and tool installation
C10 Check headlight aim
Refer to the Repair Manual for procedures.
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
Page 3 of 5
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
Under Hood
June 21, 2007
D01 Check engine oil and ATM fluid levels
D02 Check brake and power steering fluid levels
Visually inspect using see-through reservoirs.
D03 Check engine coolant level
D04 Check battery state-of-charge using Digital Battery System Analyzer
Refer to TSB No. PG001-06, “Battery Maintenance for In-Stock Vehicles
& Pre-Delivery.”
NOTE:
Battery SOC should be a minimum of 75%. Please enter the SOC Reading on the space
provided on the check sheet and attach the printout to the check sheet.
D05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks
Under Vehicle
(On Hoist)
E01 Remove disc brake anti-rust covers/anti-corrosion wheel film
Visually inspect rotors for rust.
NOTE:
For best rotor rust prevention, retain wheel film on vehicle until just prior to
customer delivery.
E02 Inspect tires for defects/damage and adjust tire pressure
(including spare tire)
The recommended tire inflation pressure changes with tire size, driving conditions,
and vehicle model. For precise tire pressure information, refer to the Owner’s
Manual and/or tire information label located on the vehicle.
Sidewall “Maximum” cold tire inflation pressure should not be used for
normal driving.
E03 Activate tire pressure monitor
E04 Install wheel covers/caps/spare tire wheel covers*
E05 Inspect for fuel, oil, coolant, and other fluid leaks
Road Test
Page 4 of 5
A complete road test helps assure customer satisfaction. Drive vehicle over a variety of
road surfaces and driving conditions. Check for unusual noises and driving performance.
F01 Check cold engine operation
Check starting and fast idle operation performance.
F02 Check engine operation during warm-up
Check that engine operates smoothly during warm-up.
Check for unusual noise, engine vibration, rough idle, etc.
F03 Check engine at normal operating temperature
Check engine performance over a broad range of driving conditions, including idle
quality, acceleration, cruise, and deceleration.
F04 Check automatic transmission operation
Check automatic transmission operation, including operation in each range, neutral
start switch, and shift lock system.
F05 Check brake and parking brake operation
Check brake function, including unusual noise, parking brake performance, and all
related brake system indicator lights.
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
2008 MY 4RUNNER PRE-DELIVERY SERVICE (PDS) – PD069-07
June 21, 2007
Road Test
(Continued)
F06 Check steering operation and off-center/vehicle pull/flutter
Check steering function.
Check steering off-center/vehicle pull/flutter.
F07 Inspect for abnormal noises and vibration
F08 Inspect for squeaks and rattles
F09 Check heater and A/C operation
F10 Check cruise control operation
Check cruise control, including On-Off switch, “SET/COAST,” “RESUME/ACCEL,”
and “CANCEL” functions.
F11 Check front seat heater operation*
F12 Set/calibrate compass*
F13 Check Rear Height Control Air Suspension*
Final
Inspection
& Cleaning
G01 Remove interior protective covers, unnecessary labels, tags, etc.
(Remove protective covers just before delivery to the customer)
Remove plastic covers from door panels, seats, head restraints, and sun visors,
as required.
Remove labels, tags, and stickers (except those containing owner information).
NOTE:
Consumer information labels, such as airbag information warning and bumper
information labels, MUST be left on the vehicle until delivery to a retail customer.
G02
G03
G04
G05
G06
G07
G08
G09
Visually inspect all interior parts for installation, damage, fit, dirt, etc.
Remove Rapgard TM protective film
Wash and clean vehicle
Inspect paint finish for scratches, chips, rust, dents, damage, etc.
Install roof rack cross bars
Install receiver towing hitch cap
Inspect exterior body parts for proper installation, damage, rust, etc.
Place oil change sticker on inside of windshield, top left corner
Complete the mileage or date recommendation and apply the oil change reminder
sticker to the inside of the windshield, top left corner. You may use your current oil
change reminder sticker or order new stickers by calling 1–800–527–6283.
G10 Install front and rear license plates
* Inspect or install when equipped or required
Page 5 of 5
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 6, 2007
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Material
Repair
Procedure
DRIVESHAFT ASSEMBLY
REPLACEMENT
Models:
’90 – ’07 Toyota
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide information regarding anti–corrosion grease
that is present on replacement driveshaft assemblies. It is important to remove this
grease prior to installing the hub nut to prevent overtightening. This also applies when
reusing an old driveshaft that may have come into contact with oil or foreign matter.
S 1990 – 2007 model year Toyota vehicles.
TOOLS & MATERIAL
Toyota Brake Cleaner or Equivalent Non–Residue Solvent
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
00289–2BC00
As Needed
Clean the threaded area of the driveshaft
with Toyota Brake Cleaner (or equivalent)
to remove the anti–corrosion grease, oil,
or foreign matter before installing the
driveshaft into the vehicle.
NOTE:
A new axle hub nut may be required
when installing the driveshaft.
Check the Repair Manual procedure
for more information.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC003-07
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 6, 2007
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Material
Repair
Procedure
DRIVESHAFT ASSEMBLY
REPLACEMENT
Models:
’04 – ’07 Scion
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide information regarding anti–corrosion grease
that is present on replacement driveshaft assemblies. It is important to remove this
grease prior to installing the hub nut to prevent overtightening. This also applies when
reusing an old driveshaft that may have come into contact with oil or foreign matter.
S 2004 – 2007 model year Scion vehicles.
TOOLS & MATERIAL
Toyota Brake Cleaner or Equivalent Non–Residue Solvent
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
00289–2BC00
As Needed
Clean the threaded area of the driveshaft
with Toyota Brake Cleaner (or equivalent)
to remove the anti–corrosion grease, oil,
or foreign matter before installing the
driveshaft into the vehicle.
NOTE:
A new axle hub nut may be required
when installing the driveshaft.
Check the Repair Manual procedure
for more information.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC004-07
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 28, 2007
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
WORLD STANDARD AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION FLUID
Models:
’04 – ’08 Toyota
World Standard (WS) Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) was introduced to reduce
maintenance costs and increase the mileage between scheduled maintenance checks.
Here are some important tips when working with ATF-WS in Toyota vehicles requiring
its use.
S 2004 – 2008 model year Toyota vehicles equipped with automatic transaxle
requiring ATF-WS.
Required
SSTs
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
PART NUMBER
QTY
DRW**
00002–11100–02
1
–
Transmission Fill System*
NOTE:
All components from this kit/set are required.
* Essential SST.
** Drawer number in SST Storage System.
NOTE:
Additional SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC010-07
Title:
WORLD STANDARD AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID – TC010-07
Important
Information
June 28, 2007
S 100,000 Maintenance Interval — Inspection only; ATF-WS does NOT require any
flushing or changing during the life of the vehicle.
S The use of Genuine Toyota ATF-WS is recommended.
S The use of additives or aftermarket fluids that are considered compatible
or substitutes may result in shift concerns and damage to the internal
transmission components.
S ATF-WS is NOT compatible with T-IV or Dexron ATF.
S Containers storing Toyota ATF-WS should always be sealed — If exposed to the
atmosphere, ATF-WS may absorb moisture and potentially cause shift concerns if
used in operation.
S One time use only.
S When performing repairs on ATF-WS equipped transaxles, it is important to use
only new, clean ATF–WS when refilling the ATM.
S ATF-WS equipped ATMs may use the overflow type procedure — Any fluid
drained from the overflow plug should be discarded following proper local
regulations and never reused. Failure to do so could result in shift concerns and
damage to the internal transmission components.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
September 1, 2006
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL
NUMBER LOCATION
Models:
All ’06 – ’07 Toyota & Scion
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S February 9, 2007: The location arrows have been updated in the illustrations for
transmission model U15# (Japan built and TMMWV built).
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
The purpose of this TSB is to assist in the identification and location of serial numbers
on 2006 – 2007 model year automatic transmissions.
NOTE:
S Per Toyota Warranty Policy & Procedure Policy 4.23:
Whenever a remanufactured or OEM automatic transmission is replaced, the serial
number from the back of the failed component must be entered in the “Transmission
Serial Number” field, which can be found on the “Additional Information” tab of the
warranty claim.
S When writing a Product Report, the serial number MUST be provided.
S Warranty policy requires shipment of ALL replaced transmissions to AWTEC, even if
the transmission is replaced with a new service unit.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2006 – 2007 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 5
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC012-06
Title:
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC012-06 Revised
Identification
Procedure
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
4Runner
2006
1GR
2UZ
Example: 06 A P 0 00001
FJ Cruiser
2007
1GR
Land Cruiser
2006
2007
2UZ
Sequoia
2006
2UZ
Tacoma
2006
1GR
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
P: Transmission Model Code (A750
(A750*))
0: Plant Code
00001: 5–Digit
5 Digit Serial Number
Tundra
2006
1GR
2UZ
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
A750E/F
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
September 1, 2006
SERIAL NUMBER
Location: Right Rear on Transmission Case
Above Transmission Pan (as shown below)
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A A 0 00001
U14#
RAV4
2006
2AZ
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
A: Transmission Model Code (U14#)
0: Plant Code
00001: 5–Digit Serial Number
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Left on
Top of Bell Housing of Transmission
(as shown below)
Page 2 of 5
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC012-06 Revised
Identification
Procedure
(Continued)
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
September 1, 2006
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A L 0 00001
Camry
U15#
(Japan Built)
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
U15#
(TMMWV
Built)
2006
2AZ
Highlander
2006
2007
3MZ
RAV4
2006
2GR
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
Avalon
2006
2007
2GR
Camry (NAP)
2006
2AZ
Sienna
2006
2007
3MZ
Solara
2006
2007
2AZ
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
L: Transmission Model Code (U15#)
0: Plant Code
00001: 5–Digit
5 Digit Serial Number
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Left on
Top of Bell Housing of Transmission
(as shown below)
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 5 6 01 00001
5: Plant (TMMWV)
6: Year of Manufacture
01 Month
01:
M th off M
Manufacture
f t
(J
(January))
00001: 5–Digit Serial Number
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Left on
Top of Bell Housing of Transmission
(as shown below)
Page 3 of 5
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC012-06 Revised
Identification
Procedure
(Continued)
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
Corolla
2006
2007
1ZZ
Matrix
2007
2ZZ
RAV4
2006
2AZ
Scion tC
2006
2007
2AZ
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
Matrix
2006
1ZZ
Scion xA
2006
1NZ
Scion xB
2006
1NZ
Yaris
2006
1NZ
U34#
Page 4 of 5
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A B 0 00001
U24#
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
September 1, 2006
06: Year of Manufacture
A Month
A:
M h off M
Manufacture
f
(A – M, “I” not used)
B: Transmission Model Code (U24#)
0: Plant Code
00001: 5–Digit
g Serial Number
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Left on
Top of Bell Housing of Transmission
(as shown below)
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A G 0 00001
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
G T
G:
Transmission
i i M
Model
d lC
Code
d (U34#)
0: Plant Code
00001: 5–Digit
5 Digit Serial Number
Location: Left Side of Transmission Bell
Housing Roughly 3/4 Up (as shown below)
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC012-06 Revised
Identification
Procedure
(Continued)
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
September 1, 2006
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 2A 06 GI 00001
U660E
Camry
2007
2GR
2: Plant ID (TMH)
A: Unit ID (U660E)
06: Year of Manufacture
G: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
I: Plant Line Number
00001: 5–Digit Serial Number
Location: Top of Bell Housing Towards
Front of Transmission — Serial Number will
be Stamped in Transmission Case
(as shown below)
Page 5 of 5
September 1, 2006
Introduction
REMANUFACTURED AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SERIAL
NUMBER LOCATION
Models:
All ’06 – ’07 Toyota & Scion
The purpose of this TSB is to assist in the identification and location of serial numbers
on 2006 – 2007 model year remanufactured automatic transmissions.
NOTE:
S Per Toyota Warranty Policy & Procedure Policy 4.23:
Whenever a remanufactured or OEM automatic transmission is replaced, the serial
number from the back of the failed component must be entered in the “Transmission
Serial Number” field, which can be found on the “Additional Information” tab of the
warranty claim.
S When writing a Product Report, the serial number MUST be provided.
S Warranty policy requires shipment of ALL replaced transmissions to AWTEC, even if
the transmission is replaced with a new service unit.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2006 – 2007 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
Technical Service
BULLETIN
TC013-06
Title:
REMANUFACTURED AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC013-06
Identification
Procedure
September 1, 2006
NOTE:
Serial numbers on remanufactured transmissions are highlighted with paint.
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
4Runner
2006
1GR
2UZ
FJ Cruiser
2007
1GR
Land Cruiser
2006
2007
2UZ
Sequoia
2006
2UZ
Tacoma
2006
1GR
Tundra
2006
1GR
2UZ
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
A750E/F
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A P 0001 A
06: Year
06
Y
off M
Manufacture
f t
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
P: Transmission Model Code
0001: 4–Digit Serial Number
A: Remanufactured Service Digit
Location: Right Rear on Transmission
Case in Front of Tail Shaft Flange
(as shown below)
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A A 0001 A
U14#
RAV4
2006
2AZ
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
A: Transmission Model Code (U140#)
0001: 4–Digit Serial Number
A: Remanufactured Service Digit
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Right
on Top of Bell Housing of Transmission
(as shown below)
Page 2 of 4
REMANUFACTURED AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC013-06
Identification
Procedure
(Continued)
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
U15#
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
Avalon
2006
2007
2GR
Camry
2006
2AZ
Highlander
2006
2007
3MZ
RAV4
2006
2GR
Solara
2006
2007
2AZ
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
Corolla
2006
2007
1ZZ
Matrix
2007
2ZZ
RAV4
2006
2AZ
Scion tC
2006
2007
2AZ
September 1, 2006
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A L 0001 A
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M,
M “I” not used)
L: Transmission Model Code (U15##)
0001: 4–Digit
g Serial Number
A: Remanufactured Service Digit
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Right
on Top of Bell Housing of Transmission
(as shown below)
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A B 0001 A
U24#
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A
( – M, “I” not used))
B T
B:
Transmission
i i M
Model
d lC
Code
d
0001: 4–Digit Serial Number
A: Remanufactured Service Digit
Location: Slightly Off Center to the Rear
of Transmission (as shown below)
Page 3 of 4
REMANUFACTURED AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBER LOCATION – TC013-06
Identification
Procedure
(Continued)
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
MODEL
MODEL
YEAR
ENGINE
Matrix
2006
1ZZ
Scion xA
2006
Scion xB
2006
Yaris
2006
SERIAL NUMBER
Example: 06 A G 0001 A
06: Year of Manufacture
A: Month of Manufacture
(A – M, “I” not used)
G T
G:
Transmission
i i M
Model
d lC
Code
d
0001: 4–Digit Serial Number
A: Remanufactured Service Digit
U34#
Page 4 of 4
September 1, 2006
1NZ
Location: Top Canter of Transmission Bell
Housing on Case Rim (as shown below)
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT VIN PLATES
Models:
All Toyota Models
November 20, 2007
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. PG009–02.
TSB No. PG009–02 is now obsolete and should be discarded. The changes will take
place January 1, 2008.
Introduction
Replacement VIN plates (metal plates riveted to dashboard) may be available from
Toyota providing the request meets the criteria listed in this TSB.
VIN Plate Location
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG007-07
Title:
REPLACEMENT VIN PLATES – PG007-07
Replacement
VIN Plate
Criteria
November 20, 2007
A replacement VIN plate may be requested ONLY if:
S The vehicle is in an accident and the VIN plate is damaged.
S The vehicle was stolen and the VIN plate is damaged but still available.
NOTE:
S The original
VIN plate being replaced MUST accompany
the request.
S If the VIN plate is stolen, be sure to contact the State Police or your State’s
Department of Motor Vehicles (DMV). In most cases, the State DMV will issue
a unique number so that the original number can be included on stolen
vehicle listings. If this is the case, a replacement VIN plate is NOT available
from Toyota. However, the original VIN, NOT the state issued VIN, must be
used on all warranty claims.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement VIN plate, complete a copy of the form at the end of this
bulletin. Note that the damaged VIN plate MUST accompany the request form. Your
dealer parts account will be billed $40.00 for each replacement of a damaged VIN plate.
NOTE:
All replacement VIN plates are subject to approval by the Technical Compliance
Department. If you have any specific questions, contact (310) 468–3390.
Page 2 of 3
REPLACEMENT VIN PLATES – PG007-07
November 20, 2007
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT VIN PLATE
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
OTHER
REASON/EXPLANATION
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
ATTACH DAMAGED PLATE HERE
NOTE:
S The original
VIN plate being replaced MUST accompany
the request.
S If a VIN plate is stolen, be sure to contact the State Police or your State’s Department
of Motor Vehicles (DMV). In most cases the State DMV will issue a unique number so
that the original number can be included on stolen vehicle listings. If this is the
case, a replacement VIN plate is NOT available from Toyota. However, the original
VIN, NOT the state issued VIN, must be used on all warranty claims.
S Your dealer parts account will be billed $40.00 for the replacement VIN plate.
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
DEPT.
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD VIN PLATE TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA. 90509–2991
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 6, 2007
Introduction
SRS COMPONENT DISPOSAL AS
HAZARDOUS MATERIAL TREATMENT
Models:
’98 – ’08 Toyota (SRS–Equipped)
Some hazardous material treatment and handling regulations at the state and local level
now define the pre–disposal deployment of airbag and pre–tensioner assemblies as
hazardous material treatment. Hazardous material treatment may require special training,
certification or licensing in certain areas. TMS recommends dealership personnel
carefully review and follow all local and state regulations and, where necessary, contract
with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Licensed Hazardous Waste Transportation
and Disposal facilities.
TMS no longer recommends the manual deployment of SRS components as a
general practice method of disposal. Employment of an EPA Licensed Hazardous
Waste Transportation and Disposal contractor is encouraged.
Reasons for the change in practice:
S Previously, deployed SRS components were considered to be non–hazardous waste
and airbag deployment was an acceptable practice when performed safely by
properly equipped service facilities.
S The EPA has deferred the responsibility of determining if airbags, deployed or
un–deployed, constitute hazardous waste to the discretion of each state.
S Within the past several years, a number of states have ruled the deployment of
airbags to be considered treatment of hazardous waste, requiring practicing
dealerships to obtain a HAZMAT treatment facility permit.
S Airbag disposal practices and protocols vary from state to state and are
continuously evolving.
For information on local regulations, contacts for EPA Licensed Hazardous Waste
Transportation and Disposal providers, an up–to–date list of states that require
“waste treatment permits” for SRS component deployment, as well as more
information about airbag recycling opportunities, please consult the Environmental
Assistance Network (EAN). website http://www.ccar-greenlink.org/tms and enter the
keywords “airbag disposal”.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 1998 – 2008 model year Toyota vehicles equipped with SRS.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS004-07
Title:
SRS COMPONENT DISPOSAL AS HAZARDOUS MATERIAL TREATMENT – SS004-07
Repair
Manual
Changes
Special
Service Tools
Toyota service publications explain in detail the procedures for pre–disposal
deployment of airbag and pre–tensioner assemblies. These practices should ONLY
be used by EPA Licensed Hazardous Waste Transportation and Disposal facilities or
dealership technicians IF allowable by local/state regulation. All future service
publications will include additional cautions advising dealership associates to review
and abide by all applicable regulations prior to performing any pre–disposal deployment
or disposal activity.
Special Service Tools (SSTs) for airbag and pre–tensioner deployment are no longer
classified as essential SSTs. These tools will continue to be available through the SST
program for dealerships choosing to continue airbag deployment in compliance with state
and local governance. Refer to the following table for a list of current pre–disposal
deployment SSTs and applications.
COMPONENT NAME
PART NUMBER
APPLICATION
09082–00705–01
Tool kit containing SSTs listed below
Airbag Deployment Tool
09082–00700
Airbag ignition source/
triggering device
Seat Belt Pretensioner Wire
09082–00740
Connects deployment tool to seat belt
pretensioner assembly
Side Airbag Deployment Wire
09082–00750
Connects deployment tool to side
airbag assembly
Driver/Passenger Deployment Wire
09082–00760
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub–Harness #5
09082–00770
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub–Harness #6
09082–00780
Wire “A”
09082–10801
Wire “B”
09082–20801
Wire “C”
09082–30801
Airbag Deployment Tool Kit
Connects deployment tool to
airbag assembly
NOTE:
SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Page 2 of 2
August 6, 2007
Technical Service
BULLETIN
July 31, 2007
Introduction
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SHIPPING
BAG FOR WARRANTY RECOVERY
Models:
’91 – ’08 Toyota (w/ATM)
The automatic transmission shipping bag is available from the Material Distribution
Center (MDC) to assist in sealing an automatic transmission from leaking during
shipping. This bag is primarily intended to be used when shipping ATMs for which
plastic shipping containers are not yet available. This TSB contains ATM bag ordering
and shipping information.
NOTE:
If an automatic transmission leaks while being shipped, it may be returned to sender.
S 1991 – 2008 model year Toyota vehicles equipped with automatic transmission.
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
*
Ordering
Information
MDC MATERIAL NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
COST
00108–01090
ATM Poly Bag Box Liner for
Warranty Recovery
1*
$0.00
Five bags in each. Maximum quantity is 1 five–pack per order.
1. Go to Dealer Daily.
2. Click on the Parts link.
3. Click on the Dealer Support Materials Catalog link.
The ATM bag is located on page 25 of the catalog.
4. To order ATM shipping bags, follow the information on Form 1450 (available on
page 13).
Shipping
Information
Warranty
Information
IMPORTANT SHIPPING HINTS:
S When shipping a transmission or transaxle, ensure as much fluid as possible is
drained from the transmission and torque converter.
S Clean the remaining fluid off of the case.
S Ensure the torque converter hold–down strap is securely installed.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC012-07
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
October 23, 2007
Introduction
EXTERIOR COLOR AND SCRATCH
RESISTANT AND ANTI-ACID PAINT
Models:
’07 All Models
Most colors on Toyota vehicles sold in the U.S. use a combination of scratch resistant
and/or acid rain resistant exterior (body color) paint finishes. These types of finishes
provide improved resistance to minor scratching and acid rain.
This bulletin outlines the precautions that should be taken when polishing or refinishing
anti–scratch automotive type paint surfaces.
The repair of acid rain damaged paint surfaces is explained in TSB No. BO020–91,
“Prevention and Repair of Acid Rain Damage”.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2007 model year Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
PAINT
PA003-07
Title:
EXTERIOR COLOR AND SCRATCH RESISTANT AND ANTI–ACID PAINT – PA003-07
Paint
Application
MODEL
PLANT
4Runner
TMC
Avalon
TMMK
TMMK
Camry
TMC
NUMMI
&
TMMC
Corolla
TMC
FJ Cruiser
TMC
Highlander
TMC
SCRATCH
RESISTANT
PAINT
ANTI–ACID
PAINT
All Except
056
All Except
056
All Colors
All Colors
056
1D4
1E9
1F4
202
3Q3
070
1D4
1E3
202
3Q7
4Q2
6UO
8P4
8R5
–
–
–
040
1D4
1G3
202
3R3
4Q2
All Except
040
All Except
040
6U6
776
8S4
8T5
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
1D4
1G3
202
3R3
4Q2
All Except
040
All Except
040
6U6
776
8S4
8T5
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
1E3
1E7
209
3P1
4Q2
All Except
040
All Except
040
775
8P4
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
1E3
1E7
209
3P1
775
All Except
040
All Except
040
8P4
–
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
–
Only 1D4,
3P2, 5A3,
8T6, 211
Only 1D4,
3P2, 5A3,
8T6, 211
All Exce
Exceptt
040
All Exce
Exceptt
040
All Colors
All Colors
2JR 2JT 2JU 2JV 2JW
(058/ (058/ (058/ (058/ (058/
1D4) 3P2) 5A3) 8T6) 211)
040
1C0
4R3
6T5
8N6
8P4
202
3Q3
–
–
–
–
Highlander
g
040
1C0
202
4R3
6T5
8N6
HV
–
–
–
–
–
–
056
1D2
1E9
1F7
202
3Q2
All Except
056
All Except
056
4R3
8R3
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
1E3
1E7
209
3L5
8P1
All Except
040
All Except
040
8P4
8Q5
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
1F7
1G3
202
3R3
4S2
All Except
040
All Except
040
6UO
8S2
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
070
1E0
1F7
202
3R3
All Except
040
All Except
040
4R4
6T6
8R3
8S6
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
040
071
1D6
1F9
202
3Q7
All Except
040
All Colors
4Q2
4T3
6T8
8S6
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
056
071
1D7
1F9
3Q3
4Q2
All Except
056
All Except
056
6UO
8R5
8S6
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
TMC
Land Cruiser
Matrix
Prius
RAV4
Sequoia
Sienna
Page 2 of 4
EXTERIOR COLOR AVAILABILITY
October 23, 2007
TMMC
TMC
TMC
TMMI
TMMI
EXTERIOR COLOR AND SCRATCH RESISTANT AND ANTI–ACID PAINT – PA003-07
Paint
Application
(Continued)
MODEL
PLANT
Solara
TMMK
SCRATCH
RESISTANT
PAINT
ANTI–ACID
PAINT
All Colors
All Colors
070
1D4
1G3
202
3P0
8Q5
8T7
–
–
–
–
–
040
1E7
209
3L5
3P1
4Q2
All Except
040
All Except
040
Deck
8P1
8P4
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
Cab
040
1E7
209
3L5
3P1
4Q2
All Except
040
All Except
040
8P1
8P4
–
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
TMMTX
040
1D6
1F9
202
3L5
3Q3
All Except
040
All Colors
TMMI
4Q2
4T3
6T8
8S6
8T9
–
All Colors
All Colors
068
1E7
1F8
209
3P0
4S9
All Except
068
All Except
068
6S3
8P4
8T0
8T1
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
068
1E0
1E7
209
3R3
6U4
All Except
068
All Except
068
777
8R3
8S6
–
–
–
All Colors
All Colors
Cab
Tacoma
EXTERIOR COLOR AVAILABILITY
October 23, 2007
TMMBC
NUMMI
Deck
Tundra
Yaris
TMC
Yaris
Hatchback
Page 3 of 4
EXTERIOR COLOR AND SCRATCH RESISTANT AND ANTI–ACID PAINT – PA003-07
Polishing Tips
October 23, 2007
Polishing Tips for Anti–Scratch Finishes:
Since this type of paint technology is meant to resist scratching, it is important to
understand that sanding and polishing to remove scratches is quite difficult and will
require significantly more time to finesse the paint surface to achieve an
acceptable appearance.
S Use an ultra–fine grit sandpaper to remove scratches.
S Soak sandpaper in soapy water for at least one hour (overnight preferred) prior to
sanding the paint surface (this will reduce the possibility of rescratching the
paint surface).
S Use polishing compounds and materials specifically designed to be used with
clearcoated urethane paint finishes.
Refinish Recommendations:
NOTE:
To improve appearance and durability of the refinished paint surface, it is
recommended that a clearcoat be used when refinishing color 202 (non–metallic
black). All metallic and pearl coat finishes MUST be clearcoated. Please refer to the
specific refinish recommendations issued by the paint manufacturer used by the
body/paint shop.
Refinish materials providing similar scratch resistant qualities to that of the original factory
finish have been developed by the refinish paint suppliers in the U.S. Please contact your
refinish supplier for a list of appropriate refinish materials as well as specific
refinish instructions.
Page 4 of 4
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABELS
Models:
All Toyota Models
November 20, 2007
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. PG008–02.
TSB No. PG008–02 is now obsolete and should be discarded. The changes will take
place January 1, 2008.
Introduction
Replacement Certification Labels (vinyl label affixed to driver’s door or door post)
may be available from Toyota providing the request meets one of the criteria listed in
this TSB.
Certification Label Location
MFD.BY:TOYOTA MOTOR MANUFACTURING,
KENTUCKY, INC. 06/07
GVWR 4345LB GAWR FR 2668LB RR 2359LB
THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO ALL APPLICABLE
FEDERAL MOTOR VEHICLE SAFETY, BUMPER, AND
THEFT PREVENTION STANDARDS IN EFFECT ON
THE DATE OF MANUFACTURE SHOWN ABOVE.
4T0XX00X0X000000
PASS.CAR
C/TR:8S4/FB13 ACV40L CEANKA
A/TM: 03A/U250E
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
64393
S All Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG008-07
Title:
REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABELS – PG008-07
Certification
Label Criteria
November 20, 2007
A replacement certification label may be requested if:
S The vehicle is in an accident and the label is damaged or is attached to a part that will
be replaced during the repair.
S The label is stolen.
NOTE:
S Processing of a replacement label will be delayed if the original (or copy/picture)
certification label does NOT accompany the request.
S A replacement label MAY NOT be available if the vehicle is more than 5 years old.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement label, complete a copy of the form at the end of this bulletin.
Your dealer parts account will be billed $40.00 for each replacement of a damaged or
stolen label.
NOTE:
All replacement labels for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Page 2 of 3
REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABELS – PG008-07
November 20, 2007
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABEL
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
STOLEN
OTHER
REASON/EXPLANATION
ATTACH ORIGINAL LABEL HERE
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
NOTE:
S Processing of a replacement label will be delayed if the original (or copy/picture)
certification label does NOT accompany the request.
S A replacement label MAY NOT be available if the vehicle is more than 5 years old.
S Your dealer parts account will be billed $40.00 for the replacement label.
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
DEPT.
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD LABEL TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA 90509–2991
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
August 11, 2007
Introduction
ABSORBED GLASS MAT (AGM)
BATTERY INFORMATION
Models:
’01 – ’08 Toyota
This TSB provides background on the differences and similarities between AGM
(Absorbed–electrolyte Glass Mat) batteries and flooded lead acid batteries. It also
explains charging procedures performed by the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station
(SST P/N 00002–MCGR8) and its ability to charge AGM batteries at higher current
levels then a standard battery charger.
S 2001 – 2008 model year Toyota vehicles equipped with an AGM battery.
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Equipment
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station*
*
SUPPLIER
PART NUMBER
QTY
SPX/OTC
00002–MCGR8
1
Essential SSTs.
NOTE:
The GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station (P/N 00002–MCGR8) supersedes the Automatic
Trickle Charger (P/N 00002–YA122–01) and Fast Battery Chargers (Associated P/N
ASE6003 and Christie P/N CAPPDQ). P/N 00002–YA122–01, ASE6003, and CAPPDQ
are now obsolete.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS006-07
Title:
ABSORBED GLASS MAT (AGM) BATTERY INFORMATION – SS006-07
Battery
Comparison
August 11, 2007
Differences between AGM and flooded lead acid batteries:
S AGM batteries have thin, sponge–like, glass mat separators that absorb all
liquid electrolytes.
S Flooded lead acid batteries have free, liquid electrolyte all around the plates
and separators.
S Flooded lead acid batteries can easily release gas that is formed during a charge,
while AGM battery life is diminished if gas is formed during charging.
Similarities between AGM and flooded lead acid batteries:
S Both share the exact same lead acid chemistry.
S Both share the same charge and discharge principles.
S Both are safely charged by vehicle charging systems.
S When discharged, both can be recharged at high current levels.
Battery
Charging
Information
Damage to AGM batteries becomes an issue when the charge rate is NOT monitored
and controlled by the charger (i.e., quick chargers). The performance of an AGM battery
can be irreversibly reduced if the charge rate remains too high, allowing the battery to
overheat and vent. Once an AGM battery loses water (venting), the glass mats will
become dry, causing the battery to lose conductance, power, and performance.
In most vehicle charging systems, the alternator limits the charging rate by limiting the
output voltage (about 14.4V). For example, an AGM battery may be observed charging
at 60A and 13.5V. As the battery recharges, the charging voltage will increase from
13.5V to approximately 14.4V (voltage will vary based on temperature, control
sophistication, etc.), and the current will decrease from 60A to about 0A. The charging
system voltage regulators prevent both AGM and flooded lead acid batteries from being
overcharged and venting. By controlling the voltage, the charging rate (current) can
be controlled.
The discontinued Special Service Tool (SST) Automatic Trickle Charger (SST P/N
00002–YA122–01) maintained a manual charging limit of 10A to accomplish a safe
recharge rate for AGM batteries. This low amp charge was low enough to prevent the
AGM battery from overheating and venting since the charger had no way of monitoring
battery temperature/condition.
The GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station (SST P/N 00002–MCGR8) is a customized
diagnostic fast charger that monitors battery temperature/conditions and contains custom
charging rates for ALL model batteries used for Toyota and Scion vehicles. As such, it
safely charges good batteries as fast as possible to a point where they can be returned
to service and eliminates wasted charging time by quickly diagnosing bad batteries.
Page 2 of 3
ABSORBED GLASS MAT (AGM) BATTERY INFORMATION – SS006-07
Battery
Charging
Information
(Continued)
August 11, 2007
Based on the characteristics and performance measures of each individual battery
(i.e., custom charging rate), the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station will apply the fastest
charging rate that is safe for that particular battery.
S When the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station performance measurements indicate that
an AGM battery qualifies for fast–charging, it will be charged at whatever current level
it will accept, but the charging voltage will be controlled so that it does NOT exceed
14.4V, and the battery temperature will NOT exceed 135°F (57°C).
S When the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station performance measurements indicate that
an AGM battery does NOT qualify for fast–charging, the charge session will only
continue if the battery qualifies for “Recovery” mode (part of which means, NO
defects or other serious performance issues were found).
It is recommended that ALL Toyota and Scion vehicle batteries be charged using the
GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station.
NOTE:
S NEVER connect the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station to remote battery terminals.
S ALWAYS connect the GR8 Battery Diagnostic Station DIRECTLY to the vehicle battery.
For assistance on charging procedures, refer to the GR8 Instruction Manual or
TSB No. PG001–06, “Battery Maintenance for In–Stock Vehicles & Pre–Delivery”.
The GR8 Instruction Manual can be found on the Technical Information System (TIS),
Diagnostics – Battery – “GR8 Instruction Manual”.
Page 3 of 3
March 25, 2008
T-SB-0020-08
Disconnect Battery & Perform Zero Point Calibration
After Wheel Alignment Adjustment
Service
Category
Brake
Section
Brake Control/Dynamic Control System
Market
USA
Applicability
YEAR(S)
MODEL(S)
1998 – 2009
4Runner, Avalon,
Camry, Camry HV,
Corolla, FJ Cruiser,
Highlander, Highlander
HV, Land Cruiser,
Matrix, Prius, RAV4,
Sequoia, Sienna,
Solara, Tacoma,
Tundra
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Introduction
The purpose of this TSB is to provide information on when and how to perform the zero point
calibration on vehicles equipped with Vehicle Stability Control (VSC). Momentarily disconnecting the
battery is a necessary step for performing the zero point calibration.
Warranty Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
© 2008 Toyota Motor Sales, USA
Page 1 of 2
Page 2 of 2
March 25, 2008
T-SB-0020-08
Disconnect Battery & Perform Zero Point Calibration After Wheel Alignment
Adjustment
Required Tools & Equipment
REQUIRED EQUIPMENT
SUPPLIER
PART NUMBER
QTY
ADE
TSPKG1
1
TIS techstream*
NOTE: Software version 2.20.015 or later is required.
* Essential SST.
NOTE
• Additional TIS techstream units may be ordered by calling Approved Dealer Equipment (ADE)
at 1-800-368-6787.
• The Toyota Diagnostic Tester and CAN Interface Module may also be used to perform the
service procedures listed in this bulletin.
Preliminary Information
Perform this procedure if any of these repairs have been performed on the vehicle:
• Wheel alignment has been adjusted.
• Any chassis components have been removed/installed or replaced.
Repair Procedure
1. Disconnect the cable from the negative (–) battery terminal for MORE THAN two (2) seconds.
2. Reconnect the cable to the negative (–) battery terminal.
3. Perform the applicable zero point calibration of the yaw rate sensor and/or the steering
angle sensor.
HINT
Refer to the applicable TSB or Repair Manual for the zero point calibration procedure.
4. Re-initialize all applicable systems available on the vehicle (power window, sunroof, power
lift door, etc.).
© 2008 Toyota Motor Sales, USA
SEAT BELT EXTENDER
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’08 Toyota & Scion
March 12, 2008
Introduction
Toyota and Scion customers who find it necessary
to increase the length of their seat belts may
obtain Seat Belt Extenders at no cost through
their local Toyota dealer.
Seat Belt
S The extender is available in 6-inch,
9-inch, 12-inch, 15-inch, and 18-inch lengths.
S The extender is available only in black.
Extender
S Owners are informed of the Seat Belt Extender
availability through the Toyota Owner’s Manual
included in each vehicle.
The customer (individual requiring the extender) must visit a Toyota or Scion dealership
to have the required measurements made and to complete the Seat Belt Extender
Worksheet. The worksheet will allow the proper fitting and selection of a Seat Belt
Extender for the customer. The dealership personnel should then determine the
applicable part number and place an order through Dealer Daily.
The dealership service department should complete the affixed Seat Belt Extender
Customer Information Label on the part and review the “Owner Instructions” (page 7) with
the customer. The dealership should give a copy of the completed worksheet and Owner
Instructions to the customer and keep the originals in the customer’s file.
To assure utmost owner satisfaction, it is recommended that a dealership designate one
person to coordinate all activities related to the Seat Belt Extender issue.
It is recommended that dealerships do NOT stock Seat Belt Extenders due to the need
for proper fitting to individual customers.
This bulletin contains the following information:
Procedure and Sample Label . . . . . . . . . . Page 2
Application Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 3 – 5
Part Number Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 6
Owner Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 7
Seat Belt Extender Worksheet . . . . . . . . . Page 8
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2008 model year Toyota and Scion vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 8
BODY
BO001-08
Title:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
Procedure
March 12, 2008
1. Customer requests a Seat Belt Extender from dealer.
2. Dealer verifies the need for a Seat Belt Extender and obtains a current copy of this
TSB and copies the worksheet.
3. Dealer measures the customer and completes the worksheet. Dealer determines the
correct part number and places an order for the part through Dealer Daily.
4. Dealer receives Seat Belt Extender and calls the customer to check the fit of the part.
5. If the Seat Belt Extender fit is good, dealership personnel completes the Customer
Information Label on the part, explains usage of the part, and gives the customer a
copy of the completed worksheet.
6. Dealer places copy of the completed worksheet in the customer’s records.
DEALER
MEASURE
CUSTOMER
&
COMPLETE
WORKSHEET
PLACE
ORDER
THROUGH
DEALER
DAILY
PARTS
SUPPLY
SHIP SEAT
BELT
EXTENDER
TO DEALER
DEALER
TEST FIT
CUSTOMER
WITH PART
COMPLETE
LABEL AND
ADVISE
CUSTOMER
OWNER
RECEIVE
COPY OF
WORKSHEET
& USE OF
EXTENDER
FILE
WORKSHEET
IN
CUSTOMER
RECORDS
Sample Seat
Belt Extender
Customer
Information
Label
CAUTION
THIS SEAT BELT EXTENDER IS TO BE USED ONLY BY:
ON VEHICLE:
VIN:
SEATING POSITION:
USE BY OTHERS, OR IN ANOTHER SEATING POSITION, OR IN ANOTHER VEHICLE
COULD REDUCE SEAT BELT RESTRAINT IN AN ACCIDENT AND RESULT IN
PERSONAL INJURY.
Page 2 of 8
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
Sienna Front
Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
Sienna Rear
Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
March 12, 2008
FRONT SEAT — EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
2008
Sienna
All Models
R–8
REAR SEAT — EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
Sienna
TYPE
2008
Rear Seat 2nd Row RH –
7 Passengers
Q–6
Rear Seat 2nd Row RH –
8 Passengers
R–8
Rear Seat 2nd Row LH
R–8
Rear Seat 2nd Row & 3rd Row
Center Seat
Rear Seat 3rd Row
Right/Left Side
Q–6
R–8
Example of 2008 MY Sienna
8 Passengers
R–8
R–8
R–8
Q–6
Q–6
R–8
R–8
R–8
7 Passengers
R–8
Q–6
R–8
Q–6
R–8
R–8
R–8
Page 3 of 8
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
Front Seat
Belt Extender
Applications
March 12, 2008
TOYOTA FRONT SEAT — EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
2008
4Runner
K–6
Avalon
K–6
Camry
R–8
Camry HV
R–8
Corolla
R–8
FJ Cruiser
K–6
Highlander
Highlander HV
R–8
All Models
R–8
Land Cruiser
R–8
Matrix
R–8
Prius
R–8
RAV4
R–8
Sequoia
R–8
Solara
R–8
Tacoma
Tundra
Yaris
Bench Type Front Seat
R–7
Separate Type Front Seat
R–8
All models
R–8
K–6
SCION FRONT SEAT — EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
Scion tC
Scion xB
Scion xD
Page 4 of 8
2008
K–6
All Models
R–8
K–6
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
Rear Seat
Belt Extender
Applications
March 12, 2008
TOYOTA REAR SEAT — EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
4Runner
TYPE
2008
Without 3rd Row Seat
R–8
With 3rd Row Seat
K–5
Avalon
T–1
Camry
R–8
Camry HV
R–8
Corolla
R–8
FJ Cruiser
R–8
Highlander
R–8
Highlander HV
R–8
All Models
Land Cruiser
K–7, (K–8*3)
Matrix
T–1
Prius
R–8
RAV4
R–8
Sequoia*2
R–8
Solara
R–8
Tacoma
Tundra
Yaris
Access Cab
T–1
Double Cab
T–1
CrewMax
R–8
Double Cab
R–8
All Models
R–8
*2 An extender may not be used for the center rear seatbelt except for Sienna and Land Cruiser.
*3 Middle seat position for 2nd and 3rd row seats.
SCION REAR SEAT — EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
Scion tC
Scion xB
2008
K–5
All Models
Scion xD
K–5
K–5
NOTE:
A seat belt extender must NOT be used for the center rear seat belt.
Page 5 of 8
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
Part Number
Information
PART NUMBER PREFIX: 73399–
SERIES
Page 6 of 8
March 12, 2008
LENGTH
6 INCH
9 INCH
12 INCH
15 INCH
18 INCH
K–5
–35010
–35020
–35030
–35040
–35050
K–6
–35060
–35070
–35080
–35090
–35100
K–7
–60010
–60020
–60030
–60040
–60050
K–8
–60060
–60070
–60080
–60090
–60100
Q–6
–AE061
–AE071
–AE081
–AE091
–AE101
R–7
–48010
–48020
–48030
–48040
–48050
R–8
–50060
–50070
–50080
–50090
–50100
T–1
–01110
–01120
–01130
–01140
–01150
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
Owner
Instructions
March 12, 2008
Failure to follow the recommendations indicated below could result in reduced
effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle collision, causing
personal injury.
If your seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, a
personalized Seat Belt Extender is available from your Toyota or Scion dealer free
of charge.
Please visit your local Toyota or Scion dealer so that the dealer can order the proper
required length extender. Bring the heaviest coat you expect to wear for proper
measurement and selection of length. Additional ordering information is available at your
Toyota or Scion dealer.
When the Seat Belt Extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic locking
retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when in use.
To connect the extender to the seat
belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the buckle-release
buttons of the extender and the seat
belt are both facing outward as shown.
Seat Belt Release
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
When not in use, remove the extender
and store in the vehicle for future use.
Seat Belt Extender
Buckle
CAUTION:
On vehicles equipped with SRS – Occupant Classification System (OCS)*, it is
critical that the extender tab be buckled into the buckle AFTER the occupant sits
down in the seat.
Leaving extender installed in the buckle before sitting down will cause the OCS to be
in the “airbag off” or disarmed state.
*
OCS will enable or disable the passenger front and side airbags based on passenger weight and seat belt
latch position classifying the passenger as a child or adult.
CAUTION:
When using the Seat Belt Extender, observe the following. Failure to follow these
instructions could result in reduced effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in
case of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
S NEVER use the Seat Belt Extender if you can COMFORTABLY fasten the seat belt
without it.
S The Seat Belt Extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when used on a
different vehicle, or for another person or at a different seating position than the
one originally intended for.
Page 7 of 8
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’08 TOYOTA & SCION – BO001-08
March 12, 2008
SEAT BELT EXTENDER WORKSHEET
PLEASE COPY THIS ORIGINAL WORKSHEET FOR EACH EXTENDER NEEDED
CAUTION:
S To minimize the chance and/or severity of injury in an accident, the Seat Belt Extender must only be used:
1 By the person for whom it was provided.
2 In the seat position for which it was provided.
S The Seat Belt Extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S When the Seat Belt Extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic locking retractor),
make sure the retractor is locked when extender belt is in use.
DEALER
DEALER CODE
SEAT BELT EXTENDER APPLICATION
DEALER NAME
APPLICANT
APPLICANT NAME
ADDRESS
ADDRESS
CITY & STATE
EMPLOYEE NAME
MODEL YEAR
ZIP
CITY & STATE
BODY TYPE
SEATING POSITION
ZIP
PHONE
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
DIRECTIONS FOR DETERMINING PROPER EXTENDER LENGTH
1.
2.
Place the seat in the position the applicant normally uses.
With the applicant in the seat, wearing the thickest coat expected to be worn, pull belt all the way out and try to
buckle belt.
S If belt latches into buckle and feels comfortable against upper chest area, an extender is not needed.
S If belt does not buckle, continue with Step 3.
S If buckle latches but belt has no slack remaining, continue with Step 3.
3. Measure distance between applicant’s navel and seat belt buckle (Dimension A) and enter on Worksheet.
4. With belt all the way out, measure distance between latch tip and buckle tip (Dimension B) and enter
on Worksheet.
NOTE: If belt latches but there is no slack enter zero as Dimension B.
5. Subtract Dimension B from Dimension A and record number in Check Number box on Worksheet.
6. Seat Belt Extender length is Dimension B rounded up to next extender length (without exceeding
Check Number).
NOTE: If extender length exceeds Check Number, an extender cannot be provided to the customer.
CAUTION:
On vehicles equipped with SRS – Occupant Classification System (OCS), it is critical that the extender
tab be buckled into the buckle AFTER the occupant sits down in the seat.
Leaving extender installed in the buckle before sitting down will cause the OCS to be in the “airbag off”
or disarmed state.
Dimension A:
NAVEL TO BUCKLE
Buckle
Navel
Dimension B:
LATCH TO BUCKLE
Latch
A
B
Buckle
SEAT BELT EXTENDER CALCULATION
DIMENSION A:
DIMENSION B:
CHECK NUMBER:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER AUTHORIZATION
S The same Seat Belt Extender can be used for right and left seating applications. Each Seat Belt
Extender will have a label identifying the owner, VIN and seating position.
S Applicant’s Signature:
Date:
(Actual user of Seat Belt Extender)
Page 8 of 8
Technical Service
BULLETIN
January 19, 2008
Introduction
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT:
VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE
Models:
’08 Toyota
This bulletin contains general vehicle pulling diagnosis and repair procedures along with
specific information to help correct pulling complaints.
This information supplements Repair Manual procedures for the following symptoms:
S When the driver holds the steering wheel without exerting steering effort while driving
straight ahead, the vehicle drifts to the right or the left.
S While driving straight ahead, the driver has to steer either to the right or the left to
maintain straight driving.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 2008 model year Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
044184
Preliminary Check & Road Test
0.6
Combo A
Switch Front Tire/Wheel & Road Test
0.5
Combo B
Reverse the Front One Side Tire
0.7
Combo C
Check Front Wheel Alignment
1.2
Combo D
Adjust Front Wheel Alignment
0.7
Combo E
Adjust Camber Setting
0.7
420091
Dismount and Mount Tire and Balance Wheel
and Tire Assembly
0.5
Each additional Wheel
0.3
Combo A
OFP
T1
T2
45046 09020
45046–09020
31 99
42611–08010
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 12 months or 20,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 11
SUSPENSION
SU001-08
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Contents
January 19, 2008
This bulletin is divided into the following sections:
Wheel Alignment and Tire Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 3–4
Repair Procedure Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 5
Repair Procedures
1. Important Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 6
2. Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 6–7
3. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 7–8
4. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Tire Conicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 8–10
5. Camber Adjustment Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 10–11
Page 2 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Wheel
Alignment &
Tire
Characteristics
January 19, 2008
1. Relationship Between Wheel Alignment and Vehicle Pulling
When the cross camber or caster of the front wheel alignment is large, it can cause
vehicle pulling.
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
DIRECTION OF VEHICLE PULLING
Camber
Vehicle pulls in direction of wheel with large camber value
Caster
Vehicle pulls in direction of wheel with small caster value
CAMBER
Straight-Ahead
Driving
CASTER
Direction of Pull
Front
P’
T’
P
T
a’
a
Caster Trail
(Large)
Caster Trail
(Small)
O
F
O’
F’
P, P’: Driving Force
a, a’: Steering Axes
O, O’: Center of Tire-Road
Contact Area
F, F’: Reactive Force
If the cross camber or caster is within the specified range (30’ or less), noticeable vehicle
pulling will not occur due to side-to-side differences in camber or caster.
NOTE:
On a flat road, if the cross camber or caster is 30’ or less and the steering wheel is
held without exerting steering effort for 109 yards (100 m) when driving at 62 mph
(100 km/h), the alignment-induced drift distance is approximately 1.64 ft (0.5 m).
Page 3 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Wheel
Alignment &
Tire
Characteristics
(Continued)
January 19, 2008
2. Relationship Between Tire Characteristics and Vehicle Pulling to One Side
When radial tires are rotating, they have the characteristic of generating lateral force
between the tire and the road surface. This lateral force is comprised of two factors:
S Ply-steer, which changes direction according to the rotation direction of the tires.
S Conicity, which is generated in a fixed direction regardless of the tire
rotation direction.
If these lateral forces are too strong, vehicle pulling will occur.
A. Ply–Steer
Lateral force due to ply-steer is produced by the construction of the belts inside
the tire tread. With radial tires, the wire of the belt is slanted as shown in the
illustration below. Thus, it is in this direction that tire tread easily changes shape
(stretches), and lateral force is generated between the tire and the road surface.
Rotation Direction
Easily–Stretched
Direction
Wire
Ply–Steer
(Direction of Force Generation Varies
According to Tire Rotation)
Belt
NOTE:
Lateral force from ply-steer prevents vehicle drift caused by road slant, so in many
cases lateral force to the left is provided to prevent or minimize vehicle drift.
B. Conicity
Conicity is lateral force resulting from uneven formation of the left and right sides
of the tire. The direction the lateral force is exerted depends on the hardness of
the side walls and the difference in height between the left/right sides of the tire.
Hard
Part
Conicity
(Direction Is Fixed Regardless of
Direction of Tire Rotation)
NOTE:
S In the case of vehicle pulling caused by tires, the lateral force which is exerted as a
result of conicity has the greatest effect. On a flat road, if the steering wheel is held
without exerting steering effort for 109 yards (100 m) when travelling at 62 mph
(100 km/h), the vehicle may drift as much as 5 ft (1.5 m).
S When vehicle pulling is due to conicity, the amount of drift can be reduced and the
direction of drift can be changed by changing the location of the tire or reversing
the tire when installing it on the wheel.
Page 4 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedure
Flow Chart
January 19, 2008
START
Preliminary Check
S Tire Pressure
S Vehicle height
S Brake Dragging
NO Is there steering
off center?
*ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle lead/pull?
YES
NO
COMPLETE
YES
Adjust front tie rods.
See TSB ST003-01
YES
Are the tires uni–directional type?
NO
NO
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
Cross switch front tire and wheel
assemblies (left & right)
YES
Choose the position of front tire & wheel
assemblies where there is least amount of pull.
YES
Does the vehicle lead/pull in the
same direction as before?
NO
YES
Check front wheel alignment.
Is it within specification?
NO
Is the lead/pull stronger
than before?
NO
YES
Reverse the front left side
tire and rebalance it.
Adjust front wheel alignment.
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
NO
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
YES
YES
Does the vehicle
lead/pull to the left?
COMPLETE
YES
NO
Increase right front camber and decrease left
front camber until lead/pull is eliminated.
NO
NO
NOTE: Do not exceed 1_ of
cross camber.
Do not exceed adjustment range.
Increase left front camber and decrease right
front camber until lead/pull is eliminated.
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still lead/pull?
YES
Contact your regional office.
* Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line for 109 yards (100 m) at a constant speed
of 35 mph (56 km/h). Please confirm safety and set the steering wheel to its straight position. Drive the vehicle
in a straight line for 109 yards (100 m) at a constant speed of 35 mph (56 km/h) without exerting steering effort
on the steering wheel.
(1) The vehicle goes straight but the steering wheel has some angle.
(2) The vehicle does not go straight.
STEERING OFF CENTER
STEERING PULL
Page 5 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedures
January 19, 2008
1. Important Notice
Before repairing vehicle pulling, it is necessary to clearly identify the cause of the
pulling condition. Frequently, the cause of the vehicle pulling is diagnosed as wheel
alignment. However, the actual cause may be lateral force generated by the tires.
Performing wheel alignment when tire force is the cause could result in the wheel
alignment being set at a value outside of specifications. This may then result in other
problems such as uneven tire wear, etc.
2. Troubleshooting
First determine whether vehicle pulling is caused by a wheel alignment problem or tire
characteristics, then decide which repairs to make.
A. Perform the following checks and correct as necessary.
a. Check tires for size, wear and for proper inflation pressure.
b. Check whether the vehicle is noticeably tilted backward/forward or left/right.
NOTE:
Tilting of the vehicle produces a left–right difference in the camber and caster and can
cause vehicle pulling.
c. Check brakes for dragging.
B. Confirm problem symptoms.
With the customer accompanying you, drive the vehicle to confirm if the
customer’s complaint involves vehicle pulling to one side or steering wheel off
center. If the problem is steering wheel off center, adjust the front tie rods on the
vehicle. Refer to Toyota TSB No. ST003-01. Also check the direction of vehicle
pulling and the extent of the pulling.
C. Determine if vehicle pulling is due to wheel alignment or tires.
a. Switch the left and right front tires (If the tires are non-unidirectional).
b. Conduct a drive test to check whether the vehicle pulling direction
has changed.
Page 6 of 11
SYMPTOM
PROBABLE CAUSE
CORRECTIVE ACTION
No change in vehicle
pulling condition
Front wheel alignment
Proceed to Repair Procedure 3. Vehicle pulling
caused by Wheel Alignment (Page 7)
Vehicle pulling
eliminated
Tire conicity
Repair complete. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Tire
Conicity (Page 4 and 8)
Vehicle pulling
direction is reversed
Tire conicity
Proceed to Repair Procedure 4. Vehicle Pulling
Caused by Tire Conicity (Page 8)
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
January 19, 2008
Helpful hints to determine cause of vehicle pulling:
S The direction of lateral force from tire conicity becomes reversed when the left
and right tires are switched. Therefore, if the pulling direction changes when
the tires are switched, it can be concluded that vehicle pulling is caused by
tire conicity.
ORIGINAL TIRE POSITIONS
Vehicle Pulling
Direction (Right)
TIRES SWITCHED
Lateral Force by
Conicity
The Vehicle is Pulled to the Right by
the Lateral Force Exerted to the Right.
Vehicle Pulling
Direction (Left)
Lateral Force by
Conicity
The Direction of the Tires Which Exerted Lateral
Force to the Right has Been Changed, so the Tires
Now Exert Lateral Force to the Left and the Vehicle
Now Pulls to the Left.
S If the pulling direction does not change after the front tires are switched, the
cause of vehicle pulling is not tire conicity. In this case, the likely cause is a
front wheel alignment condition.
3. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Wheel Alignment
When it is determined by troubleshooting that the vehicle pulling is caused by wheel
alignment, perform repairs according to the following procedure.
Vehicle Pulling to One Side
Check Front Wheel Alignment
Not Within Specification
Within Specification
Adjust Front Wheel Alignment
Road Test
OK
Within Specification But
Vehicle Pulls
Vehicle Still Pulls
Adjust Cross Camber to Eliminate Vehicle Pulling
NOTE: Do not exceed 1_ of cross camber.
Page 7 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
January 19, 2008
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO LEFT
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO RIGHT
Increase right front camber and decrease left
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
Increase left front camber and decrease right
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
NOTE:
S Keep the cross camber within 1_ or less.
S Keep the camber of each wheel within specifications (+/–45’ of center value).
S If adjustment exceeds the specifications, uneven tire wear will result.
4. Vehicle Pulling Caused by Tire Conicity
When it is determined by troubleshooting that the vehicle pulling is caused by tire
conicity, perform repairs according to the following procedures.
Indication of Tire Conicity as a Cause:
When the front tires are switched, the pulling direction changes. Proceed to STEP 1.
STEP 1:
Remove the front left tire from the wheel and reverse the tire. Then perform a road
test and check for change in the pulling direction.
HINT:
By performing this operation, it can be checked whether the left or right tire exerts a
stronger lateral force. Either tire can be reversed. Shown here is an example of the left
tire reversed.
If Vehicle Pulls in the Same Direction: Go to STEP 2.
The lateral force generated by the right front tire is greater than the left tire, so
the vehicle is pulling due to the lateral force of the right tire.
ORIGINAL TIRE POSITIONS
Vehicle Pulling
Direction
LEFT TIRE REVERSE INSTALLATION
Vehicle Pulling Direction
(Same Direction)
Reversed
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
Page 8 of 11
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
January 19, 2008
If Vehicle Pulls in the Opposite Direction: Go to STEP 2.
The lateral force generated by the left front tire is greater than the right tire, so
the vehicle is pulling due to the lateral force of the left tire.
ORIGINAL TIRE POSITIONS
LEFT TIRE REVERSE INSTALLATION
Vehicle Pulling
Direction
Vehicle Pulling
Direction
(Opposite Direction)
Reversed
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Larger)
Lateral Force by
Conicity (Smaller)
If Vehicle Pull Is Eliminated: Repair Is Now Complete.
STEP 2:
Rotate the larger lateral force front tire with the rear tire and check the change in the
vehicle pulling.
NOTE:
By shifting the front tire with the larger lateral force to the rear, vehicle pulling is
usually reduced.
If Vehicle Is Still Pulling: Go to STEP 3.
If Vehicle Pull Is Eliminated: Repair Is Now Complete.
Page 9 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
January 19, 2008
STEP 3:
Adjust cross camber to eliminate vehicle pulling.
HINT:
If the tires are placed in the positions they were in during tire rotation when the least
amount of vehicle pulling occurred, wheel alignment can be performed with a minimal
amount of adjustment.
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO LEFT
WHEN VEHICLE PULLS TO RIGHT
Increase right front camber and decrease left
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
Increase left front camber and decrease right
front camber until vehicle pulling is eliminated
NOTE:
S Keep the cross camber within 1_ or less.
S Keep the camber of each wheel within specifications (+/–45’ of center value).
S If adjustment exceeds the specifications, uneven tire wear will result.
5. Camber Adjustment Method
NOTE:
S After the camber has been adjusted,
inspect the toe-in.
S The method of camber adjustment
differs for different models, so please
refer to the repair manual of the
vehicle involved. (This is a sample
from the Sienna Repair Manual).
A. Remove the front wheels and
ABS speed sensor clamp.
B. Remove the two nuts on the lower
side of the shock absorber.
C. Coat the threads of the nuts with
engine oil.
D. Temporarily install the two nuts.
E. Adjust the camber by pushing
or pulling the lower side of the
shock absorber in the direction
in which the camber adjustment
is required.
F. Tighten the nuts.
1
2
Page 10 of 11
REPAIR MANUAL SUPPLEMENT: VEHICLE PULLING TO ONE SIDE – SU001-08
Repair
Procedures
(Continued)
January 19, 2008
G. Install the front wheels.
Torque: 104 NSm (1,050 kgfScm, 77 ftSlbf)
H. Check the camber.
NOTE:
Adjusting value for the set bolts is
6’ – 30’ (0.1_ – 0.5_).
When making an adjustment of more
than 45’, replace the upper and lower
steering knuckle set bolts with the
adjusting bolts. If the camber is NOT
within the specification, use the table
shown to estimate how much
additional camber adjustment will be
required, and select the appropriate
camber adjusting bolt.
I.
Follow steps 5-A through 5-H
again. Between steps 5-B and
5-C, exchange one or two
selected bolts.
HINT:
When exchanging the two bolts, exchange one bolt each time.
If Vehicle Pull Is Eliminated: Repair Is Now Complete.
If Vehicle Is Still Pulling: Contact Toyota Technical Assistance.
Page 11 of 11
FOREWORD
This manual has been prepared for use when
performing terminal repairs, wire repairs, or connector
repairs on vehicles.
A step–by–step section on connector repair and
terminal repair is included.
There is a section of charts with terminal and connector
illustrations, part numbers, and notes on terminal
removal.
By using this guide, a satisfactory repair of the wiring
harness and connectors in Toyota vehicles will be easy
to achieve.
All information in this manual is based on the latest
product information at the time of publication. However,
specifications and procedures are subject to change
without notice.
2002
All rights reserved. This book may not be
reproduced or copied, in whole or in part, without the
written permission of Toyota Motor Corporation.
G
(Cont. next page)
1
2
3
4
5
M:11063
F:11065
M:11064
F:11066
M:11181
F:11182
6
7
8
9
10
G–6
402
Waterproof Type [1]
11
10
1.0
M:11863
1 0 III
1.0
F:11856
M:11188
F:11189
13
1.3
F:10737
18
1.8
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
F:11166
F:11243
F:11363
F:11428
F:11252
M : Male
M:10580
M:10475
F:10476
M:10590
F:10609
F:10474
M:10575
M:10892
F:10893
M:11006
F:11007
M:11270
F:11271
M:10842
F:10843
M:10886
F:10887
M:10898
F:10899
M:10900
F:10901
M:11072
F:10923
M:10959
F:10947
M:10948
F:10949
M:11002
F:11003
M:11004
F:11005
M:11008
F:11009
F : Female
M:11191
F:11192
M:11173
F:11174
F:10711
M:10592
23
2.3
M:11171
F:11172
M:10650
F:10532
M:10648
F:10598
M:11486
F:11019
M:11029
F:11030
M:11137
F:11038
M:11050
F:11051
M:11069
F:11070
M:11073
F:11075
M:11074
F:11075
M:11141
F:11142
M:11155
F:11156
M:11168
F:11162
F:10572
M:11247
F:11248
M:11272
F:11273
F:11207
F:10974
F:11246
F:11025
F:11250
M:11015
F:11016
M:11131
F:11132
M:11244
F:11245
M:11295
F:11245
F:11068
F:11255
F:10834
F:11140
F:11285
F:10845
M:10868
F:10869
M:10941
F:10942
M:11027
F:11028
M:11122
F:11037
M:11177
F:11178
M:11291
F:11292
F:11149
F:12028
F:10902
F:10943
F:11144
F:11153
F:10919
F:11150
F:11858
F:11154
F:10981
F:11152
F:11163
F:11020
F:11235
F:11143
F:11145
F:11261
F:11294
F:11349
M:11348
M:11078
F:11077
F:11317
M:10987
F:10988
M:11033
F:11034
M:11193
F:11194
M:11196
F:11197
M:11289
F:11290
F:11599
F:10854
F:11024
F:11049
F:11232
M:10930
F:10931
M:10890
F:10891
M:10890
F:11190
M:10896
F:10897
F:11231
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
F:11062
M:10495
F:10496
2 3 II
2.3
M:11169
F:11170
Waterproof Type [1] (Cont’d)
12
15
10
1.0
40
80
F:11215
F:11214
1 0 III
1.0
13
1.3
F:11698
M:11088
F:11089
18
1.8
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
23
2.3
M:11086
F:11087
F:11151
2 3 II
2.3
M : Male
F : Female
G–7
403
G
G
404
48
4.8
63
6.3
77
7.7
80
8.0
1
M:10982
F:10983
F:11400
M:10246
F:10247
M:10114
F:10115
M:10836
F:10837
M:11183
F:11184
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
HB4
PIN
F:11237
M:10156
F:10157
4
M:10989
F:10990
M:11035
F:11036
5
6
8
9
10
11
23
F:11095
F:11659
F:11096
M:11945
F:11660
M:10577
M:10240
F:10241
F:10554
M:10244
F:10353
1 0 III+4
1.0
III+4.8
8
F:12020
2 3+6 3
2.3+6.3
F:10686
M:11160
F:11161
2 3 II+4.8
2.3
II+4 8
M:10749
F:10844
F:10940
M:10945
F:10946
M:11021
F:11022
M:11412
F:11413
F:10939
M:10894
F:10895
M:11239
F:11643
F:11332
F:11784
F:11195
2 3 II+6.3
2.3
II+6 3 II
F:11323
M:11241
F:11242
2 3 II+8.0
2.3
II+8 0
M:11044
F:11045
4 8+8 0
4.8+8.0
M : Male
34
M:10838
F:10839
M:11031
F:11032
TLC
TODC
3
M:10840
F:10841
M:10944
F:10841
M:10347
F:10249
F : Female
M:11138
F:11139
F:12021
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
HB3
2
M:10927
F:10928
G–8
Waterproof Type [2]
Non–waterproof Type [1]
1
(Cont. next page)
2
3
4
5
F:11988
F:11921
6
7
8
9
10
11
10
1.0
1 0 II
1.0
M:11967
F:11919
1 0 III
1.0
F:11924
F:11909
13
1.3
M:11052
F:11053
M:11186
F:11187
F:11471
F:11107
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
F:11436
F:11319
F:11948
F:11616
F:11165
M:11532
F:11533
M:11623
F:10630
F:11494
F:11450
F:11041
F:11642
F:11083
F:11657
18
1.8
1 8 II
1.8
M:10437
F:10355
23
2.3
2 3 II
2.3
M:10824
F:10825
M:10833
F:10825
M:11299
F:10825
M:11300
F:10825
M:10849
F:10850
M:10859
F:10860
M:11060
F:10860
M:10905
F:10906
M:10934
F:10935
M:11159
F:11148
F:11080
M:10907
F:10908
F:11098
F:11071
F:11227
F:11079
F:10823
F:11278
F:10835
F:11608
F:10855
F:10962
F:10504
M:10384
F:10414
F:10601
M:10794
F:10795
M:10858
F:10795
M:11399
F:10795
M:11012
F:11013
M:11023
F:10904
M:11100
F:11090
M:11085
F:10789
M:10796
F:10797
M:11110
F:10797
M:11099
F:10933
M:11101
F:10996
M:10998
F:11001
M:11010
F:11011
M:11587
F:11011
F : Female
F:10672
F:10957
F:10964
F:11280
F:10322
M:11528
F:11529
M:10798
F:10799
M:11534
F:11535
F:10669
M:10800
F:10801
M:11102
F:10997
M:11536
F:11537
M:10829
F:10830
M:11538
F:11539
F:10966
F:10822
F:10965
G–9
405
M : Male
M:10870
F:10871
M:11026
F:10871
M:11097
F:10871
M:11146
F:11147
M:10573
F:10365
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
M:11211
F:11212
M:11368
F:11369
G
G
406
12
10
1.0
1 0 II
1.0
13
14
15
16
F:11129
F:10764
F:11408
F:11219
17
18
19
20
21
22
25
F:11220
28
34
F:11218
F:11221
G–10
Non–waterproof Type [1] (Cont’d)
F:11391
F:11925
1 0 III
1.0
F:11911
M:11654
F:11556
F:11913
F:11179
M:11573
F:11574
M:11570
F:11571
F:11125
F:11264
M:11962
F:11927
M:11926
F:11915
M:11503
F:11502
M:11133
F:11055
F:11628
F:11043
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
M:10722
18
1.8
F:10658
F:10973
F:10697
F:10656
F:10696
F:10743
1 8 II
1.8
23
2.3
2 3 II
2.3
F:11424
M:10513
F:10432
M:10325
F:10326
M:10802
F:10803
M:11530
F:11531
M:10804
F:10805
M:11541
F:11542
F:10967
F:11604
F:10968
F:11121
F:11661
M : Male
F:11433
F : Female
M:10806
F:10807
F:10852
M:10827
F:10828
M:10808
F:10809
M:11167
F:10848
F:11417
M:10818
F:10819
M:10810
F:10811
M:10820
F:10821
M:10977
F:10875
F:11552
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
13
1.3
F:11914
Non–waterproof Type [2]
1
M:11258
F:11259
48
4.8
F:10911
2
M:10915
F:10916
M:11093
F:11094
3
F:10980
4
M:11135
F:11136
M:11878
F:11742
5
F:10912
M:10178
F:10179
63
6.3
M:10213
F:10214
6
M:10975
F:10976
M:10283
F:10216
F:11778
8
M:10963
F:10926
F:11091
F:11092
F:11583
F:11615
M:10172
F:10173
F:11686
M:10174
F:10175
9
10
M:10861
F:10862
12
13
14
17
22
M:10176
F:10177
F:10619
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
F:10786
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
F:10792
77
7.7
M:10994
F:10995
80
8.0
M:10356
F:10357
M:10958
F:10903
M:11655
F:11579
F:11684
FOG LP
FOG–LP
F:10956
M:10866
F:10867
F:11314
F:11685
F:10481
FTC
HEAD LANP
HEAD–LANP
F:10489
F:10487
F:10490
F:10488
F:10428
M:10131
LAC
F:10133
M:10289
LC
F:10645
MFPC
F : Female
F:10301
F:10302
F:10303
F:10304
F:10372
F:10369
G–11
407
M : Male
F:10132
1
2
(Cont. next page)
3
MIC
4
5
6
7
8
F:10378
9
10
12
F:10152
13
14
15
G–12
408
Non–waterproof Type [3]
16
F:10062
OBD II
F:11665
PULSE
LOCK
F:10294
F:11116
SFPC
F:10351
F:10371
F:11114
F:11113
F:11115
F:10070
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
SP
F:10071
F:10362
F:10376
M:10401
F:10402
TLC
M:10466
F:10467
TNS
TODC
M:10719
F:10528
M:10182
F:10183
F:10635
M:10470
F:10471
M:10040
F:10274
M:10044
F:10045
1 0+1 8
1.0+1.8
1 0 II+1.8
1.0
II+1 8 II
F:11225
F:11565
1 0 III+2.3
1.0
III+2 3 II
M:11613
F:11042
1 3+2 3 II
1.3+2.3
F:11056
2 3+6 3
2.3+6.3
M : Male
F:10463
F : Female
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
SL
Non–waterproof Type [3] (Cont’d)
17
MIC
18
20
22
23
24
25
26
32
F:10037
OBD II
PULSE
LOCK
F:10295
F:10296
F:10350
SFPC
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
SL
SP
TLC
TNS
M:10552
F:10526
M:10599
F:10587
F:10765
F:10925
TODC
1 0+1 8
1.0+1.8
F:10918
F:10763
M:11223
F:11226
1 0 II+1.8
1.0
II+1 8 II
M:11223
F:11224
M:11222
F:11392
F:11390
1 0 III+2.3
1.0
III+2 3 II
1 3+2 3 II
1.3+2.3
F:11671
F:11594
F:11595
F:11469
M:11504
F:11469
M:10920
F:10921
M:11208
F:10921
F:11423
F:11877
M:11158
F:11058
2 3+6 3
2.3+6.3
M : Male
F : Female
G–13
409
410
4
M:11126
F:11118
5
M:10985
F:10986
6
2 3 II+4.8
2.3
II+4 8
8
M:10876
F:10877
10
M:11596
F:11527
F:11130
F:10993
11
M:10872
F:10873
12
M:10878
F:10879
14
M:10812
F:10813
15
M:10814
F:10815
16
M:10884
F:10885
19
M:10882
F:10883
20
M:10816
F:10817
24
M:10880
F:10881
G–14
Non–waterproof Type [4]
26
M:11631
F:10932
F:11279
F:11701
M:10909
F:10910
2 3 II+8.0
2.3
II+8 0
4 8+8 0
4.8+8.0
F:10888
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
M : Male
F:10889
F:10447
F : Female
APPENDIX–PART NUMBER LIST
6 3+7 7
6.3+7.7
M:10856
F:10857
G–2
APPENDIX–REPORTING OF WIRE HARNESS PROBLEM
REPORTING OF WIRE HARNESS PROBLEM
It is more difficult to understand the cause of wire harness problems and to make
production improvements, due to the number of wire harness routings and connectors and
their wide scope of use.
The position of the problem occurrence and the problem cause will be very clear if you
proceed with wire harness/connector repairs.
We request that when you perform repairs, you fill in the attached ”WIRE
HARNESS/CONNECTOR PROBLEM CHECK SHEET” and send it to your distributor.
Toyota Motor Corporation will be able to make production improvements more quickly and
surely based on the results of the above mentioned reports (Check Sheets).
G
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
398
G–3
APPENDIX–REPORTING OF WIRE HARNESS PROBLEM
G
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
399
G–4
APPENDIX–REPORTING OF WIRE HARNESS PROBLEM
G
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
400
G–5
APPENDIX–REPORTING OF WIRE HARNESS PROBLEM
G
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
401
G–1
APPENDIX–WIRE HARNESS REPAIR KIT WITH CASE
WIRE HARNESS REPAIR KIT WITH CASE (REFERENCE ONLY)
We would like to recommend to you use of the ”Wire Harness Repair Kit with the Case”
according to your after service market demand.
Example:
or
G
[portable type]
[stationary type]
Remark: This kind of kit is not available from Toyota Motor Corporation.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
397
B–2
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–CONNECTOR REPAIR
CONNECTOR REPAIR
The repair parts now in supply are limited to those connectors having common shapes and terminal
cavity numbers. Therefore, when there is no available replacement connector of the same shape or
terminal cavity number, please use one of the alternative methods described below. Make sure that the
terminals are placed in the original order in the connector cavities, if possible, to aid in future diagnosis.
1. When a connector with a different number of terminals than the original part is used, select a connector
having more terminal cavities than required, and replace both the male and female connector parts.
EXAMPLE: You need a connector with six terminals, but the only replacement available is a connector
with eight terminal cavities. Replace both the male and female connector parts with the eight terminal part,
transferring the terminals from the old connectors to the new connectors.
2. When several different type terminals are used in one connector, select an appropriate male and female
connector part for each terminal type used, and replace both male and female connector parts.
B
EXAMPLE: You need to replace a connector that has two different types of terminals in one connector.
Replace the original connector with two new connectors, one connector for one type of terminal, another
connector for the other type of terminal.
3. When a different shape of connector is used, first select from available parts a connector with the
appropriate number of terminal cavities, and one that uses terminals of the same size as, or larger than,
the terminal size in the vehicle. The wire lead on the replacement terminal must also be the same size as,
or larger than, the nominal size of the wire in the vehicle. (”Nominal” size may be found by looking at the
illustrations in the section F or by direct measurement across the diameter of the insulation). Replace all
existing terminals with the new terminals, then insert the terminals into the new connector.
EXAMPLE: You need to replace a connector that is round and has six terminal cavities. The only round
replacement connector has three terminal cavities. You would select a replacement connector that has
six or more terminal cavities and is not round, then select terminals that will fit the new connector. Replace
the existing terminals, then insert them into the new connector and join the connector together.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
12
B–47
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
Low Fit and Lever Type Connector
[Case 1]
Lever
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
(2)
Push the place indicated by the arrow.
The lock is released and lever is lifted up.
(3)
Lift the lever up until it stops.
an
(4)
Cut the connection of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
Lever
2.
Connect the connector
(1)
Connect the connector in the condition that the lever
is fully lifted up.
HINT: If the lever is locked at the lower position, follow
the procedure [Case 1]. (1) to (3) and lift the lever up fully.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
57
B–48
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
(2)
Hold the connector to prevent it from slip off and push
it down until you hear a click to lock it.
(3)
Confirm that the lever is securely locked.
Lever
Lever is not locked
[Case 2]
Lever
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
(2)
Hold the area indicated by the arrow in the illustration
The lock is released and the lever is lifted up.
(3)
Lift the lever up fully.
(4)
Cut the connection of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
58
B–49
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
2.
Lever
Lever is not locked
Connect the connector
(1)
Connect the connector in the condition that the lever
is fully lifted up.
(2)
Hold the connector to prevent it from slip off and push
it down until you hear a click to lock it.
(3)
Confirm that the lever is securely locked.
[Case 3]
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
(2)
Pick the part indicated in the illustration by fingers.
The lock is released and the lever is lifted up.
(3)
Lift the lever up fully.
Lever
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
59
B–50
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
(4)
Cut the connection of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
2.
Lever
Connect the connector
(1)
Connect the connector in the condition that the lever
is fully lifted up.
HINT: If the lever is locked at the lower position, follow
the procedure [Case 3]. (1) to (3) and lift the lever up fully.
(2)
Hold the connector to prevent it from slip off and push
it down until you hear a click to lock it.
(3)
Confirm that the lever is securely fitted
Lever is not locked
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
60
B–51
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
Double
locking
device pin
Coil spring
The connector with secondary locking
device
1.
Area used
Wire harness for SRS airbag deployment
Pin
Convex part
Primary locking
device
Lock
2.
Cut the connection of the connector.
(1)
Release the double locking.
(2)
Release the primary locking and separate the
connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
3.
Connect the connector
(1)
Lock
Install the primary locking device and connect the
connector.
(2)
Install the double locking device.
NOTICE:
The double locking device can not be installed unless
the primary locking device is installed.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
61
B–52
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
Connector fixed by bolts
1.
Area used
Engine control computer harness
2.
Connector A
(1)
Remove the connector A.
(2) Loose the bolt using a tool like driver until the
connector B can be removed by hand and separate
the connector.
HINT: If the bolt can not be removed, roll it while pulling
forward.
Connector B
3.
Lass than 1mm
Cut the connection of the connector.
(1)
Connector B
Connector A
Bolt
Connection of the connector
Temporarily fit the connector B.
(2) Tighten the bolt by using tool like driver and fit the
connector B completely.
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolt until feeling it lighter. Then confirm
that the width of chink of the connector B is less
than 1mm.
The bolt can be rolled after it is fitted.
If the impact wrench is used, do not let it rolling
more than three seconds. (The housing may be
deformed by generated heat)
Be sure and connect the connector B straight. Do
not incline it while connecting.
(3)
Connect the connector A.
Cross–section of the bolt
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
62
B–53
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
Push down on locking arm to unlock. Then hold the
back ribs of connector to remove connector.
(2)
Cut the Connection of the connector.
Hold back
rib to pull
connector
Locking Arm
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
2.
back ribs
Connect the Connector
(1)
(2)
Align the direction of locking feature in same direction
and mate the connector holding the back ribs in
straight direction.
Insert it until a lock securely locks, and pull the
connector lightly after the insertion, and confirm that
a lock is enabled.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
63
B–1
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–PREPARATORY ITEMS
PREPARATORY ITEMS
Tool
Gauge
Crimping tool
AMP Part No. 169060
For caulking
press sleeves
Special tool
Refer to the following illustration
To remove the
terminal
SST
09991–00500
To remove the
0.64 connector
terminal
Caliper
0–150 mm
To measure the
diameter of the
core
Press sleeve
82999–12010 (Red)
82999–12020 (Blue)
82999–12030 (Yellow)
To connect wires
08231–00045
To waterproof
the connected
section
Others
Silicon tape
B
Special Tool
Reference:
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
(mm)
Preparation of the SST to release the 0.64 connector terminal.
SST 09991–00500
HINT:
This is a SST for releasing terminals from 0.64 connectors.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
11
B–4
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Step 1. Identify the connector and the terminal type.
Confirm whether the connector you require is the non–waterproof, waterproof or combined terminal type
connector from the pictures provided in the following charts.
Connector
Description
Non–Waterproof Type
Those connectors which are not of the
waterproof or combined terminal type.
Waterproof Type
Waterproof material (hole plug or terminal
packing) is provided on the terminal/connector
body.
Combined Terminal Type
Terminals of different shape/size are located in
one connector.
B
1.
Terminal with Wire
Identify the part number of the terminal with wire by picking
out the corresponding illustration from the pictures
provided on the following charts.
HINT: In some of the illustrations, there are two part
numbers for the same illustration of terminal with wire,
because although the shapes of the terminals are
completely the same, there is a difference in with /without
gold–plating (gilded).
Remark: The length of the wire connected to the
terminal is approximately 150 mm.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
14
B–5
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
When the terminal used is gold plated, be sure to
replace it with a gold plated terminal when marking
repairs.
Do not use male and female terminals which are
made of different materials from each other.
2.
Connector Body
(a)
(b)
Identify the part number of the corresponding
terminal with wire according to the above–mentioned
1.
Identify the part number of the connector body by
picking out the correct one from the illustrations
according to the number of terminals and the shape.
HINT:
If you can find no connector which matches the type
you require, pick out male and female connector
bodies as a set which have more terminals than you
require.
For the combined terminal type connector body, pick
out and appropriate connector body for each terminal
being used.
(a)
Example:
When two types of terminal are used in one connector
body, pick out a male and female for two different
connector bodies.
Example:
Back of the
Connector Body
(b)
The part number has been stamped on the back of
the connector body. (This will continue to be done to
new types of connector.)
P/N 90980–10854
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
15
B
B–6
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
3.
Hole Plug/Terminal Packing
(a)
Hole Plug
(b)
Identify the part number of the appropriate terminal
with wire/connector body from the illustrations of
waterproof type connector according to the
above–mentioned 1 and 2.
Identify the part number of the hole plug/terminal
packing from the corresponding illustration.
Connector Body
Terminal
Packing
B
4.
Small (Red)
Sleeve
When connecting two wires using a sleeve, select the
sleeve according to the following table.
Medium (Blue)
Large (Yellow)
Wire Outside
Diameter
Sleeve Size
(Color)
0.2–1.0 mm
Small (Red)
1.0–2.0 mm
Medium (Blue)
3.0–5.0 mm
Large (Yellow)
(a)
When size is based on the outside diameter of the
wire.
Wire Outside Diameter
Insulation
Calipers
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
16
B–7
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
∗
0.3
0.5
0.85 1.25
0.3
S
M
M
0.5
M
M
0.85
M
1.25
2
3
5
M
M
L
L
M
M
M
L
L
M
M
M
L
L
L
M
M
M
M
L
L
L
2
M
M
L
L
L
L
––
3
L
L
L
L
L
L
––
5
L
L
L
L
––
––
––
∗
(b)
When size is based on the nominal size of the wire.
Sleeve size
S : Small (Red)
M : Medium (Blue)
L : Large (Yellow)
∗ Nominal size of the wire
Nominal Size of Wire
HINT: To calculate the ”Nominal Size” of the wire.
Nominal size =
3.14 x (Diameter of stripped wire harness)2
4
Wire Lead
Diameter
B
Calipers
Twist Evenly
HINT:
Outside Diameter and Nominal Size
Wire Outside Diameter
Nominal Size
Insulation
Stripped Wire Harness Section
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
17
B–8
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Step 2. Disconnect the Terminal from the Connector.
1. Disconnect Connector
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself,
not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are
disconnecting before pulling apart.
Press down type is mainly used.
Example:
Pull Up
Press Down
Press Down
Pull Up
B
2.
Refereance:
Prepare the Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
(mm)
3.
Example:
Up
Tool
Disengage the double locking device or terminal
retainer.
(a)
(b)
Terminal Retainer
Locking device must be disengaged before the
terminal locking clip can be released and the terminal
removed from the connector.
Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the
double locking device.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector
body.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
18
B–9
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type A (For 1.0II, 1.8, 2.3II, 4.8 and 8.0 of Non–Waterproof
Type Connector)
Raise Up
(1)
Special
Tool
Using the special tool, raise the retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to
the connector’s shape (number of terminals, etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
Terminal Retainer
Terminal Retainer
B
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Terminal
Retainer
Stopper
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Good
Bad
Good
[Male]
Bad
[Female]
Type B (For 1.8, 1.0 and TLC of Non–Waterproof Type
Connector)
Special Tool
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
19
B–10
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(1)
Press the special tool at a 45° angle into the locking
lug access hole as shown.
Raise the double locking device up as far as possible.
Access Hole
Remove the special tool and open the double locking
device
NOTICE:
TLC housing is not be reusable. Please replace it with
the new one after replacement of the terminal.
(2)
Tab
B
∗
∗
Open
∗
[Male]
Retainer
∗
∗ Double Locking Device.
[Female]
Type C (For TNS, FTC Type Connector)
(1)
Widen the side lock part of the retainer from side to
side using the special tool.
Side Lock
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
20
Open
B–11
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Inset the special tool into the chink between the
retainer and the terminal itself. Then pry it to the
direction of the arrow shown in the illustration and
push the retainer up to release the lock.
NOTICE:
Do not insert the special tool too much. It may cause
damage on the fit section of the terminal and the
wire harness.
TNS housing is not reusable. Please replace it with
the new one after replacement of the terminal.
(2)
Special tool
Lock
Type D (For 1.3 of Non–Waterproof Type Connector)
[Case 1]
Use the special tool to unlock the double locking
device.
(1)
∗
∗
Special Tool
∗
∗
∗ Double Locking Device.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
21
B–12
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
[Case 2]
(1) Using the special tool, push the terminal retainer
locking lug (clip) and pull the terminal retainer up to
the temporary lock position.
Locking
Lug
Special Tool
Locking
Lug
Special Tool
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Special
Tool
Terminal Retainer
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
[Case 3]
(1) Using the special tool, raise the retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Stopper
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
[Case 4]
Service hole
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
22
B–13
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(1)
Insert the special tool into the service hole and move
it to the direction of the arrow to release the lock on
the side A.
(2)
Push the lock on the side B up by the special tool and
release the lock. Then pull the retainer forward.
A
Special tool
B
Appearance when the double
locking is released
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
23
B–14
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type E (For 1.8, 2.3, 2.3II, 4.8, 6.3 and 8.0 of Waterproof
Type Connector)
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to
connector body.
Example:
Terminal Retainer : Connector body
Black or White
: Gray
Black or White
: Dark Gray
Gray or White
: Black
[Case 1]
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the
temporary lock position (Pull Type).
Special Tool
Terminal
Retainer
Special
Tool
Special Tool
Terminal
Retainer
Access Hole
( Mark)
Special Tool
[Female]
[Male]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
24
B–15
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer
access hole ( Mark) and pull the terminal retainer
up to the temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to
the connector’s shape (Number of terminals etc.), so check
the position before inserting it.
(1)
Example:
Terminal Retainer at
Full Lock Position
[Male]
Access hole
Temporary Lock Position
[Female]
HINT: In some cases insert the special tool from the
access hole on the flank of the housing.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
25
B–16
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
[Case 2]
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock
HINT: There are few cases of this type of connector
Example:
Terminal Retainer
[Male]
Press Down
Press Down
[Female]
(1)
Example:
Insert the tool straight into the access hole of terminal
retainer as shown.
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock
position.
Retainer at
Full Lock Position
Retainer at
Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
[Female]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
26
B–17
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type F (For C–Type Connector)
Service hole
(1)
Insert the special tool into the service hole.
(2)
Move the special tool to the direction of the arrow and
release the lock.
Retainer
HINT: Lift the retainer up after moving it to the direction
of the thin arrow shown in the illustration.
(3)
Special tool
Lock
Pull the retainer forward by hand and remove the
retainer from the housing.
Type G
Insert the special tool into the position shown in the
illustration. Pry it to the direction of the arrow and
push the lock up to release it.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
27
B–18
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type H (For 1.0II Type Connector)
Move the special tool into the notch of the retainer to
the direction of the arrow with the edge of the housing
as the fulcrum. Then the pull the retainer out.
NOTICE:
Do not insert the special tool into areas except
notches. (This may damage the seal ring that is
attached behind the retainer.)
(1)
(2)
As same as the procedure (1), pull the retainer
straight out using hand after releasing the lock on the
other side.
Retainer
(Yellow)
Notch
NOTICE:
Do not remove the seal rubber when pulling the
terminal out.
If the seal rubber is peeled off when puling the
terminal out, press it down to stick it to the original
condition.
Be sure and not fit the connector when the retainer
is not installed.
Seal rubber
Type I (For SFPC Type Connector)
(1)
Open the cover (white)
Condition of cover opening
Side Lock
Side Lock
Remove the side lock of the retainer. (One side)
(3) Remove the center lock of the housing.
(4) Remove the side lock of the retainer. (The other side)
NOTICE:
Following the above order is not required.
No center lock on the housing with ten poles.
(2)
Center Lock
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
28
B–19
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(5)
Move the retainer until it becomes the initial condition.
Retainer
Initial condition
Type J
[Male]
(1)
Remove the rubber plug.
(2)
Push the lock of the inner using the special tool.
Pull the wire to the direction of the arrow pushing the
lock up and remove the inner from the outer.
Rubber Plug
Outer
Lock
(3)
Inner
[Female]
(1)
Remove the rubber plug.
(2)
Insert the special tool into the outer shown in the
illustration. Then push the area A of the inner and
remove the inner from the outer.
Rubber Plug
Special tool
Outer
B
Inner
A
Illustration from side B
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
29
B–20
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type J (For Insulation Displacement Connector)
Separate Connector
Using a special tool, release the lock and separate the
connector into 2.
(1)
Special Tool
NOTICE:
Do not apply too muck force to the lock arm.
Lock
Special Tool
w/ Cover : Open Connector Cover
Using a special tool, release the lock and open the cover.
(2)
Cover
NOTICE:
Do not apply too much force to the lock arm.
Special Tool
Raise Up
Special Tool
Insert Mark
Type K (0.64 Type Connector)
(1)
Special Tool
Terminal
Retainer
Using the special tool, raise the retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to
the connector’s shape (number of terminals, etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
Terminal Retainer
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Terminal
Retainer
Stopper
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
30
B–21
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Good
Bad
Special Tool
Type L (0.64 of Insulation Displacement Connector (IDC)
Type)
Remove the Lower Housing
Using a special tool, release the lock and remove the lower
housing.
(1)
Special
Tool
Lock
Special Tool
Lock
NOTICE:
Do not apply too much force to the lock arm.
Mark the upper housing and lower housing to
prevent mistakes when putting them together.
Remove the Upper Housing
Using a special tool, release the lock and remove the upper
housing from the lock housing.
(2)
NOTICE:
Do not apply too much force to the lock arm.
Mark the upper housing and lower housing to
prevent mistakes when putting them together.
Special Tool
Lock Housing
Upper
Housing
Type M (0.64 of Splash Proof Connector)
(1)
Release Terminal retainer.
Insert Special Tool at the location shown in the figure
left.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
31
B–22
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Move Special Tool in the direction of arrow.
Terminal Retainer
[Retainer at Lock Position]
Terminal Retainer
[Retainer at Unlock Position]
(2)
Rear Holder
Release Rear holder.
Insert Special Tool at the location shown in the figure
left.
Move Special Tool in the direction of arrow.
NOTICE:
Do not remove Rear holder from Connector
housing.
If Rear holder completely comes off the housing,
replace Connector with a new one.
Rear Holder
[Rear Holder at Lock Position]
Rear Holder
[Rear Holder at Unlock Position]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
32
B–23
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Rear Holder
4.
Locking Clip
Disconnect Terminal from Connector
(a)
Determine the primary locking system from the
charts.
1. Lock Located on terminal
2. Lock Located on connector
3. Method of entry and operation
(b)
Push the terminal gently into the connector and hold
it in this position.
(c)
Insert the special tool into the connector in the
direction shown in the chart.
Move the locking clip to the unlock position and hold
it there.
NOTE: Do not apply excessive force to the terminal.
Do not pry on the terminal with the special tool.
Pull Out
Connector
Wire Harness
”Waterproof Type”
(d)
Terminal
Retainer
(e)
Carefully withdraw the terminal from the connector by
pulling the lead toward the rear of the connector.
NOTE: Do not use too much force. If the terminal
does not come out easily, repeat steps (a) through
(e).
Special
Tool
Locking
Clip
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
33
B–24
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
”Non–Waterproof Type”
Locking Clip
Terminal Retainer
4.8 Type
Insert the SST into the connector in the direction
shown in the chart.
(g) Insert the SST fully to the tool hole, and push the
terminal lance.
NOTICE:
The terminal has a lance shape, therefore, the
housing may be damaged and the terminal may get
stuck if forcibly pried by wires etc.
Insert the SST so that the stopper portion surface is
facing up.
(f)
0.64 Type
Stopper Portion
Carefully withdraw the terminal from the connector by
pulling the lead toward the rear of the connector.
NOTICE:
Removal of the terminal from housing cavity will cause
damage to the wire seal section, deteriorating
waterproofing performance. Replace the connector
with a new one.
(h)
Tool Hole
SST
Terminal Lance
NOTICE:
Do not insert the special tool into the female terminal
box. If you do so, replace the terminal with the new one
whether the terminal is broken or not.
Non–waterproof type TLC housing
NOTICE:
As for Non–waterproof type TLC housing, insert the
special tool into the housing from wire harness side.
Insert the tool from wire harness side
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
34
B–25
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Insulation Displacement Connector Type
Tool Hole
Using a special tool, push the terminal lance from the
tool hole.
(b) Carefully withdraw the terminal from the connector by
pulling the lead toward the rear of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not use too much force. If the terminal does not
come out easily, repeat step (a).
Always change the wire with the repair wire, in
accordance with page B–27.
(a)
Special
Tool
Special
Tool
Terminal Lance
0.64 Type
Special Tool
Tool Hole
Special Tool
Terminal
Lance
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
35
B–26
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
5.
Terminal Deformation
(1) Terminal Bending in Vertical Direction
Inspect the terminal and the connector for
damage.
NOTE:
The locking clip is easily damaged.
Do not reuse the damaged part.
1° or less
1° or less
(2) Terminal Bending in Horizontal Direction
3° or less
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
36
B–27
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
1.
Step 3. Replace the terminal.
Cut the Old Terminal from the Harness.
(a)
Existing
terminal
Use the new wire lead as a guide for proper length.
NOTE: If the length of wire removed is not
approximately the same length as the new piece, the
following problems may develop:
Too short –– tension on the terminal, splice, or
the connector, causing and open circuit.
Too long –– excessive wire near the connector,
may get pinched or abraded, causing a short
circuit.
Cut
New Terminal with lead
HINT: When connecting a wire harness at there or more
spots to the same connector, cut the wire harness as
shown on the left.
2.
Select the correct replacement terminal with
lead, from the supply parts.
3.
Strip insulation from wire on the harness and
replacement terminal lead.
82998–12200
Stripped insulation length (A)
approximately 8 to 11 mm
A
Existing
Harness
A
Start stripping at least 8 mm (0.31 in.) to 11 mm (0.43 in.)
away from the end of the existing harness at vehicle side
and also from the end of the repair wire.
Supplied lead
with New Terminal
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
37
B–28
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the wire when stripping the
wire harness lead. After finishing the operation,
visually inspect the wire. If there is any damage,
perform the operation again.
Good Example:
HINT:
If the wire size is not known, start with largest stripper hole
and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is
removed without nicking or cutting the wire lead.
Bad Example:
(Wire insulation is Stripped at a Slant)
(Wire Lead is Cut)
(Insulation Remains on the Lead)
4.
Wire Harness Outside Diameter
Select Correct Size of Sleeve from the Supply
Parts.
Measure the diameter of wire by using the measuring
device as following:
When size is based on the outside diameter of the
wire harness
Measure the outside diameter of the wire harness by
placing a measuring device, such as a micrometer or
Vernier Caliper, across the diameter of the insulation on
the lead and taking a reading.
(a)
Insulation
Calipers
Nominal Size of the Wire
Wire Lead
Diameter
Calipers
When size is based on the nominal size of the wire
lead.
Measure the diameter of the wire lead by placing a
measuring device, such as a micrometer or Vernier
Caliper, across the diameter of the wire lead and taking
a reading.
HINT:
To calculate the ”nominal size” of wire
Twist Evenly
Nominal size=
3.14 x (Diameter of wire lead)2
4
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
38
B–29
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Small (Red)
Use the table to determine proper sleeve size
Part Number
Medium (Blue)
Nominal size of wire
(Outside Diameter of
wire)
Small
82999–12010
0.3 or less
(1.0 – 0.2 mm)
Medium
82999–12020
0.5 – 1.25
(2.0 – 1.0 mm)
Large
82999–12030
2 or more
(5.0 – 3.0 mm)
Large (Yellow)
NOTE: For details, refer to sleeve size table on item
4 of STEP 1
5.
Good Example
Two Stripped Wires
Sleeve (Blue)
Crimp the Replacement Terminal Lead to the
Harness Lead.
(a)
Overlap the two stripped wire ends inside the sleeve
as illustrated on the left.
Pressure–Contact
Section
Bad Example
Wire in
Short Position
Wire Bend
HINT: You might find it easier if you use a miniature
special tool as a guide as you insert wires into the sleeve.
Special Tool
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
39
B–30
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Crimping
Tool
The crimping tool (AMP Part No. 169060) has color
marks on it. Place the sleeve in the correct section of
the tool according to the color of the sleeve itself.
HINT: For the crimping tool, AMP ”Part No. 169060” is
convenient to use.
Sleeve
Color Marks
(c)
”CLOSE HERE”
With the center of the sleeve correctly placed
between the crimping jaws, squeeze the crimping tool
until either end comes into contact at the section
marked by ”CLOSE HERE”.
Contact
HINT: Check to see that the sleeve and wires are still in
the correct position before closing the crimping tool ends
with steady pressure.
(d)
Pull the joined wires to either end. Make sure that they
are joined firmly by the sleeve.
NOTICE:
If the joined wires come loose the splice is defective,
so replace the sleeve and repeat the procedure.
(e)
”INS” Position
6.
10 mm (0.39 in.)
Crimp both ends of the sleeve with the crimping tool
at the ”INS” position.
Protect Joined Section
Wrap silicon tape around the joins to protect them from
moisture.
NOTE: This job is required in repairs of the engine
compartment, under the floor and other moisture entry
positions.
Three or More Times
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
40
B–31
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Three or More Times
10 mm (0.39 in.)
HINT:
Before starting the operation, thoroughly wipe dirt and
grease off the sections to be joined.
If the adhesive surfaces of two tapes come in contact
they will stick together and will not come apart, so do
not remove the backing film except when using the
tape.
Do not let oil and dust, etc. get on the tape surface.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wrap the remaining part of the sleeve with half of the
tape overlapping at each turn.
(e)
Firmly wrap the tape two times or more about 10 mm
(0.39 in.) from the other end of the sleeve, then wrap
the tape back towards the start again and firmly finish
winding the tape around the center of the sleeve.
Tape overlapping
10 mm (0.39 in.)
Ready about 100 mm (3.94 in.) of silicon tape (Part
No. 08231–00045) and peel off the film.
Stretch the silicon tape until its width is reduced by
half.
About 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the end of the sleeve,
wrap the silicon tape around the sleeve three or more
times while stretching the tape.
Two or More Times
Finish
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
41
B–32
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Step 4. Install the terminal into the connector.
HINT:
(a) Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
(b) Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
(c) Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position, if equipped.
NOTE: If reusing a terminal, check that the locking clip is
still in good condition and in the proper position.
Locking clip
(a)
Special Tool
(b)
If it is on the terminal and not in the proper position,
use the special tool to gently bend the locking clip
back to the original shape.
Check that the other parts of the terminal are in their
original shape.
NOTICE:
Do not readjust or reuse the terminal lance of the
insulation displacement connector type terminal.
Always change the wire with the repair wire.
”Insulation Displacement Connector”
Terminal Lance
Special Tool
NOTICE:
As for 0.64 type terminal, do not adjust the terminal
lance with the special tool.
”0.64 Type”
Terminal Lance
Splash Proof Type Connector
Special Tool
NOTICE:
Removal of the terminal from housing cavity will
cause damage to rubber plug material (the wire
seal), deteriorating waterproofing performance. Be
sure to replace the housing with a new one.
Check the withdrawn terminal for the following if
trying to use it again.
It is free of deformation and damage
It is free of adherents such as rubber plug
material (wire seal)
Replace any deformed terminal.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
42
B–33
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
1.
Wire
Push the Terminal into the Connector until you
hear a ”click”.
NOTE: Not all terminals will give and audible ”click”.
”Click”
”0.64 IDC Type”
”Click”
”Insulation
Displacement
Connector”
”Click”
Good Example:
Bad Example:
NOTICE:
After repairing, never let only one harness stretch.
In cese that it becomes short, do over again using
the repair wire.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
43
B–34
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
2.
Double Locking Type Connector
(with terminal retainer or double locking device)
The connector is fitted with a terminal retainer, or a double
locking device, it is in the temporary lock position at insert
the terminal.
Type A (For 1.0, 1.0II, 1.3, 1.8, 2.3II 4.8 and 8.0 of
Non–Waterproof Type Connector)
Terminal Retainer
(a)
Example:
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
Double Locking
Device
Good
(b)
Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
Bad
∗ Terminal
In Short
Position
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
[Female]
NOTE: If the terminal to locking clip does not lock firmly,
the double locking device cannot lock or terminal retainer
does not lock at full lock position so the terminal backs out
from connector.
Good
Bad
[Male]
∗ Terminal
In Short
Position
(c)
Close terminal retainer or double locking device.
The connector is fitted with a terminal retainer, or a
double locking device, return it to the full lock position.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
44
B–35
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Full Lock Position
[Female]
Full Lock Position
[Female]
Full Lock Position
[Male]
Terminal Retainer
at Temporary
Lock Position
Type B (For 1.8, 2.3, 2.3II, 4.8, 6.3 and 8.0 of Waterproof
Type)
(For Male Connector)
(a)
Terminal Locking
Clip
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
(b)
Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
45
B–36
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTE: If the terminal to locking clip does not lock firmly,
terminal retainer can not lock at full lock position so the
terminal backs out from connector.
Bad Example:
Terminal in Short
Position
Terminal
Locking Clip
Terminal
Retainer
(c)
[Case 1]
”For Case 1”
Push the terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
Full Lock Position
”For Case 2”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the full lock position.
[Case 2]
Full Lock Position
Terminal Retainer
at Temporary Lock
Position
(For Female Connector)
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
(a)
Terminal Locking Clip
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
46
B–37
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
(b)
Bad Example:
Terminal in Short
Position
NOTE: If the terminal to locking clip does not lock firmly,
terminal retainer can not lock at full lock position so the
terminal backs out from connector.
Terminal
Locking
Clip
[Case 1]
(c)
”For Case 1”
Push the terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
Full Lock Position
”For Case 2”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the full lock position.
[Case 2]
Full Lock
Position
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
47
B–38
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type C (For 0.64 Type Connector)
(a)
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
Temporary Lock Position
(b)
Insert the terminal until the terminal lance locks firmly.
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
NOTE: If the terminal to terminal lance does not lock
firmly, the double locking device cannot lock or terminal
retainer does not lock at full lock position so the terminal
backs out from connector.
(c)
Close terminal retainer.
The connector is fitted with a terminal retainer, return
it to the full lock position.
Full Lock Position
Type D (For 0.64 Splash Proof Type Connector)
(a)
Verify that the terminal retainer is at unlocked
position.
Terminal Retainer
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
48
B–39
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Verify that Rear Holder is at unlocked position.
Upper lock
NOTICE:
If Rear holder or wire seal has been removed, replace
it with new one.
Lower lock
(c)
Insert the terminal fully into the housing until it is
locked.
HINT: The terminal has a longer insertion stroke than
conventional ones.
(d)
Set Rear holder to locked position.
Push Rear holder in the direction of arrow until it is
locked.
(e)
Verify that Rear holder is at the specified position.
The rear end of Rear holder is flush with the rear end
of Housing.
Rear Holder
Rear Holder
Housing rear end
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
49
B–40
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Verify that the lock (upper side) is at the specified position
under locked status.
Lock check position, upper
Lock normal engagement position
Incomplete lock engagement
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
50
B–41
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Verify that the lock (lower side) is at the specified position
under the locked status.
Lock check position, lower
Lock normal engagement position
Incomplete lock engagement
(f)
Set Terminal retainer to Lock position.
Insert Special tool into the hole specified in the left
and push Terminal retainer.
Insert Special Tool
Special Tool
hole
(U shaped)
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
51
B–42
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(g)
Verify that Terminal retainer is inserted to the
specified position.
NOTICE:
If Terminal retainer is stopped at its middle of insertion,
holding wire, push Terminal to help it for full insertion.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
52
B–43
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
SPECIAL EXAMPLE
First fit the section A.
A
Install the lock of the section A first.
A
Install the lock of the retainer and pull the white cover
until you hear a click sound.
B
Install the convex part (A) of the outer part correctly to
the section B of the inner part.
A
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
53
B–44
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Cover
Insulation Displacement Connector
w/ Cover : CLOSE COVER
NOTICE:
Securely lock it
HINT:
When replacing it to a new connector, cut off the fixing band
without leaving it.
Fix Band
UNITE CONNECTOR
Make the projection of the front lock of the upper housing
meet the ditch of the front lock of the lower housing and fix
the rear lock.
NOTICE:
After uniting, securely lock it for not leaving the rear
lock arm deformed.
Make sure that the terminals will not become loose
by pulling the wires lightly.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
54
B–45
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Insulation Displacement Connector (0.64 Type)
Lock Housing
(a)
Install the upper housing to the lock housing.
NOTICE:
Securely Lock it.
Be careful not to mistake the upper housing and
lower housing when putting together.
Upper Housing
(b)
Upper Housing Attached Lock Housing
Make the projection of the front lock of the upper
housing attached lock housing meet the ditch of the
front lock of the lower housing and fix the rear lock.
NOTICE:
Afteruniting, securely lock it for not leaving the rear
lock arm deformed.
Make sure that the terminals will not become loose
by pulling the wires lightily.
Be careful not to mistake the upper housing and
lower housing when putting together.
Lower
Housing
3.
When properly installed, pulling gently on the
wire lead will prove the terminal is locked in the
connector.
Wire
Pull
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
55
B–46
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
If you working on the waterproof type, make sure that
a rubber plug or a terminal gasket is inserted into the
housing securely.
4.
Secure the Repaired Wire to the Harness
If the wire is not in the conduit, or secured by other means, wrap
vinyl tape around the bundle to keep it together with the other
wires.
5.
Connect Connector
Fit the male connector to the female terminal.
NOTICE:
Do not twist the connector when fitting.
Insert it until fully locked.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
56
B–1
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–PREPARATORY ITEMS
PREPARATORY ITEMS
Tool
Gauge
Crimping tool
AMP Part No. 169060
For caulking
press sleeves
Special tool
Refer to the following illustration
To remove the
terminal
SST
09991–00500
To remove the
0.64 connector
terminal
Caliper
0–150 mm
To measure the
diameter of the
core
Press sleeve
82999–12010 (Red)
82999–12020 (Blue)
82999–12030 (Yellow)
To connect wires
08231–00045
To waterproof
the connected
section
Others
Silicon tape
B
Special Tool
Reference:
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
(mm)
Preparation of the SST to release the 0.64 connector terminal.
SST 09991–00500
HINT:
This is a SST for releasing terminals from 0.64 connectors.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
11
B–2
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–CONNECTOR REPAIR
CONNECTOR REPAIR
The repair parts now in supply are limited to those connectors having common shapes and terminal
cavity numbers. Therefore, when there is no available replacement connector of the same shape or
terminal cavity number, please use one of the alternative methods described below. Make sure that the
terminals are placed in the original order in the connector cavities, if possible, to aid in future diagnosis.
1. When a connector with a different number of terminals than the original part is used, select a connector
having more terminal cavities than required, and replace both the male and female connector parts.
EXAMPLE: You need a connector with six terminals, but the only replacement available is a connector
with eight terminal cavities. Replace both the male and female connector parts with the eight terminal part,
transferring the terminals from the old connectors to the new connectors.
2. When several different type terminals are used in one connector, select an appropriate male and female
connector part for each terminal type used, and replace both male and female connector parts.
B
EXAMPLE: You need to replace a connector that has two different types of terminals in one connector.
Replace the original connector with two new connectors, one connector for one type of terminal, another
connector for the other type of terminal.
3. When a different shape of connector is used, first select from available parts a connector with the
appropriate number of terminal cavities, and one that uses terminals of the same size as, or larger than,
the terminal size in the vehicle. The wire lead on the replacement terminal must also be the same size as,
or larger than, the nominal size of the wire in the vehicle. (”Nominal” size may be found by looking at the
illustrations in the section F or by direct measurement across the diameter of the insulation). Replace all
existing terminals with the new terminals, then insert the terminals into the new connector.
EXAMPLE: You need to replace a connector that is round and has six terminal cavities. The only round
replacement connector has three terminal cavities. You would select a replacement connector that has
six or more terminal cavities and is not round, then select terminals that will fit the new connector. Replace
the existing terminals, then insert them into the new connector and join the connector together.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
12
B–3
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
These steps must be followed when replacing a terminal.
Step 1. Identify the connector and the terminal type.
B
Step 2. Disconnect the terminal from the connector.
Step 3. Replace the terminal.
Step 4. Install the terminal into the connector.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
13
B–4
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Step 1. Identify the connector and the terminal type.
Confirm whether the connector you require is the non–waterproof, waterproof or combined terminal type
connector from the pictures provided in the following charts.
Connector
Description
Non–Waterproof Type
Those connectors which are not of the
waterproof or combined terminal type.
Waterproof Type
Waterproof material (hole plug or terminal
packing) is provided on the terminal/connector
body.
Combined Terminal Type
Terminals of different shape/size are located in
one connector.
B
1.
Terminal with Wire
Identify the part number of the terminal with wire by picking
out the corresponding illustration from the pictures
provided on the following charts.
HINT: In some of the illustrations, there are two part
numbers for the same illustration of terminal with wire,
because although the shapes of the terminals are
completely the same, there is a difference in with /without
gold–plating (gilded).
Remark: The length of the wire connected to the
terminal is approximately 150 mm.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
14
B–5
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
When the terminal used is gold plated, be sure to
replace it with a gold plated terminal when marking
repairs.
Do not use male and female terminals which are
made of different materials from each other.
2.
Connector Body
(a)
(b)
Identify the part number of the corresponding
terminal with wire according to the above–mentioned
1.
Identify the part number of the connector body by
picking out the correct one from the illustrations
according to the number of terminals and the shape.
HINT:
If you can find no connector which matches the type
you require, pick out male and female connector
bodies as a set which have more terminals than you
require.
For the combined terminal type connector body, pick
out and appropriate connector body for each terminal
being used.
(a)
Example:
When two types of terminal are used in one connector
body, pick out a male and female for two different
connector bodies.
Example:
Back of the
Connector Body
(b)
The part number has been stamped on the back of
the connector body. (This will continue to be done to
new types of connector.)
P/N 90980–10854
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
15
B
B–6
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
3.
Hole Plug/Terminal Packing
(a)
Hole Plug
(b)
Identify the part number of the appropriate terminal
with wire/connector body from the illustrations of
waterproof type connector according to the
above–mentioned 1 and 2.
Identify the part number of the hole plug/terminal
packing from the corresponding illustration.
Connector Body
Terminal
Packing
B
4.
Small (Red)
Sleeve
When connecting two wires using a sleeve, select the
sleeve according to the following table.
Medium (Blue)
Large (Yellow)
Wire Outside
Diameter
Sleeve Size
(Color)
0.2–1.0 mm
Small (Red)
1.0–2.0 mm
Medium (Blue)
3.0–5.0 mm
Large (Yellow)
(a)
When size is based on the outside diameter of the
wire.
Wire Outside Diameter
Insulation
Calipers
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
16
B–7
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
∗
0.3
0.5
0.85 1.25
0.3
S
M
M
0.5
M
M
0.85
M
1.25
2
3
5
M
M
L
L
M
M
M
L
L
M
M
M
L
L
L
M
M
M
M
L
L
L
2
M
M
L
L
L
L
––
3
L
L
L
L
L
L
––
5
L
L
L
L
––
––
––
∗
(b)
When size is based on the nominal size of the wire.
Sleeve size
S : Small (Red)
M : Medium (Blue)
L : Large (Yellow)
∗ Nominal size of the wire
Nominal Size of Wire
HINT: To calculate the ”Nominal Size” of the wire.
Nominal size =
3.14 x (Diameter of stripped wire harness)2
4
Wire Lead
Diameter
B
Calipers
Twist Evenly
HINT:
Outside Diameter and Nominal Size
Wire Outside Diameter
Nominal Size
Insulation
Stripped Wire Harness Section
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
17
B–8
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Step 2. Disconnect the Terminal from the Connector.
1. Disconnect Connector
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself,
not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are
disconnecting before pulling apart.
Press down type is mainly used.
Example:
Pull Up
Press Down
Press Down
Pull Up
B
2.
Refereance:
Prepare the Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
(mm)
3.
Example:
Up
Tool
Disengage the double locking device or terminal
retainer.
(a)
(b)
Terminal Retainer
Locking device must be disengaged before the
terminal locking clip can be released and the terminal
removed from the connector.
Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the
double locking device.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector
body.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
18
B–9
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type A (For 1.0II, 1.8, 2.3II, 4.8 and 8.0 of Non–Waterproof
Type Connector)
Raise Up
(1)
Special
Tool
Using the special tool, raise the retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to
the connector’s shape (number of terminals, etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
Terminal Retainer
Terminal Retainer
B
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Terminal
Retainer
Stopper
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Good
Bad
Good
[Male]
Bad
[Female]
Type B (For 1.8, 1.0 and TLC of Non–Waterproof Type
Connector)
Special Tool
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
19
B–10
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(1)
Press the special tool at a 45° angle into the locking
lug access hole as shown.
Raise the double locking device up as far as possible.
Access Hole
(2)
Remove the special tool and open the double locking
device
NOTICE:
TLC housing is not be reusable. Please replace it with
the new one after replacement of the terminal.
Tab
B
∗
∗
Open
∗
[Male]
Retainer
∗
∗ Double Locking Device.
[Female]
Type C (For TNS, FTC Type Connector)
(1)
Widen the side lock part of the retainer from side to
side using the special tool.
Side Lock
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
20
Open
B–11
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(2)
Inset the special tool into the chink between the
retainer and the terminal itself. Then pry it to the
direction of the arrow shown in the illustration and
push the retainer up to release the lock.
NOTICE:
Do not insert the special tool too much. It may cause
damage on the fit section of the terminal and the
wire harness.
TNS housing is not reusable. Please replace it with
the new one after replacement of the terminal.
Special tool
Lock
Type D (For 1.3 of Non–Waterproof Type Connector)
[Case 1]
Use the special tool to unlock the double locking
device.
(1)
∗
∗
Special Tool
∗
∗
∗ Double Locking Device.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
21
B–12
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
[Case 2]
(1) Using the special tool, push the terminal retainer
locking lug (clip) and pull the terminal retainer up to
the temporary lock position.
Locking
Lug
Special Tool
Locking
Lug
Special Tool
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Special
Tool
Terminal Retainer
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
[Case 3]
(1) Using the special tool, raise the retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Stopper
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
[Case 4]
Service hole
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
22
B–13
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(1)
Insert the special tool into the service hole and move
it to the direction of the arrow to release the lock on
the side A.
(2)
Push the lock on the side B up by the special tool and
release the lock. Then pull the retainer forward.
A
Special tool
B
Appearance when the double
locking is released
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
23
B–14
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type E (For 1.8, 2.3, 2.3II, 4.8, 6.3 and 8.0 of Waterproof
Type Connector)
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to
connector body.
Example:
Terminal Retainer : Connector body
Black or White
: Gray
Black or White
: Dark Gray
Gray or White
: Black
[Case 1]
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the
temporary lock position (Pull Type).
Special Tool
Terminal
Retainer
Special
Tool
Special Tool
Terminal
Retainer
Access Hole
( Mark)
Special Tool
[Female]
[Male]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
24
B–15
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(1)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer
access hole ( Mark) and pull the terminal retainer
up to the temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to
the connector’s shape (Number of terminals etc.), so check
the position before inserting it.
Example:
Terminal Retainer at
Full Lock Position
[Male]
Access hole
Temporary Lock Position
[Female]
HINT: In some cases insert the special tool from the
access hole on the flank of the housing.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
25
B–16
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
[Case 2]
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock
HINT: There are few cases of this type of connector
Example:
Terminal Retainer
[Male]
Press Down
Press Down
[Female]
(1)
Example:
Insert the tool straight into the access hole of terminal
retainer as shown.
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock
position.
Retainer at
Full Lock Position
Retainer at
Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
[Female]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
26
B–17
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type F (For C–Type Connector)
Service hole
(1)
Insert the special tool into the service hole.
(2)
Move the special tool to the direction of the arrow and
release the lock.
Retainer
HINT: Lift the retainer up after moving it to the direction
of the thin arrow shown in the illustration.
(3)
Special tool
Lock
Pull the retainer forward by hand and remove the
retainer from the housing.
Type G
Insert the special tool into the position shown in the
illustration. Pry it to the direction of the arrow and
push the lock up to release it.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
27
B–18
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type H (For 1.0II Type Connector)
(1)
Move the special tool into the notch of the retainer to
the direction of the arrow with the edge of the housing
as the fulcrum. Then the pull the retainer out.
NOTICE:
Do not insert the special tool into areas except
notches. (This may damage the seal ring that is
attached behind the retainer.)
(2)
As same as the procedure (1), pull the retainer
straight out using hand after releasing the lock on the
other side.
Retainer
(Yellow)
Notch
NOTICE:
Do not remove the seal rubber when pulling the
terminal out.
If the seal rubber is peeled off when puling the
terminal out, press it down to stick it to the original
condition.
Be sure and not fit the connector when the retainer
is not installed.
Seal rubber
Type I (For SFPC Type Connector)
(1)
Open the cover (white)
Condition of cover opening
Side Lock
Side Lock
(2)
Remove the side lock of the retainer. (One side)
(3) Remove the center lock of the housing.
(4) Remove the side lock of the retainer. (The other side)
NOTICE:
Following the above order is not required.
No center lock on the housing with ten poles.
Center Lock
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
28
B–19
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(5)
Move the retainer until it becomes the initial condition.
Retainer
Initial condition
Type J
[Male]
(1)
Remove the rubber plug.
(2)
Push the lock of the inner using the special tool.
Pull the wire to the direction of the arrow pushing the
lock up and remove the inner from the outer.
Rubber Plug
Outer
Lock
(3)
Inner
[Female]
(1)
Remove the rubber plug.
(2)
Insert the special tool into the outer shown in the
illustration. Then push the area A of the inner and
remove the inner from the outer.
Rubber Plug
Special tool
Outer
B
Inner
A
Illustration from side B
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
29
B–20
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type J (For Insulation Displacement Connector)
(1)
Special Tool
Separate Connector
Using a special tool, release the lock and separate the
connector into 2.
NOTICE:
Do not apply too muck force to the lock arm.
Lock
Special Tool
(2)
w/ Cover : Open Connector Cover
Using a special tool, release the lock and open the cover.
Cover
NOTICE:
Do not apply too much force to the lock arm.
Special Tool
Raise Up
Special Tool
Insert Mark
Type K (0.64 Type Connector)
(1)
Special Tool
Terminal
Retainer
Using the special tool, raise the retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to
the connector’s shape (number of terminals, etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
Terminal Retainer
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Terminal
Retainer
Stopper
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
30
B–21
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Good
Bad
Special Tool
Type L (0.64 of Insulation Displacement Connector (IDC)
Type)
(1)
Remove the Lower Housing
Using a special tool, release the lock and remove the lower
housing.
Special
Tool
Lock
Special Tool
Lock
NOTICE:
Do not apply too much force to the lock arm.
Mark the upper housing and lower housing to
prevent mistakes when putting them together.
(2)
Remove the Upper Housing
Using a special tool, release the lock and remove the upper
housing from the lock housing.
NOTICE:
Do not apply too much force to the lock arm.
Mark the upper housing and lower housing to
prevent mistakes when putting them together.
Special Tool
Lock Housing
Upper
Housing
Type M (0.64 of Splash Proof Connector)
(1)
Release Terminal retainer.
Insert Special Tool at the location shown in the figure
left.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
31
B–22
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Move Special Tool in the direction of arrow.
Terminal Retainer
[Retainer at Lock Position]
Terminal Retainer
[Retainer at Unlock Position]
(2)
Rear Holder
Release Rear holder.
Insert Special Tool at the location shown in the figure
left.
Move Special Tool in the direction of arrow.
NOTICE:
Do not remove Rear holder from Connector
housing.
If Rear holder completely comes off the housing,
replace Connector with a new one.
Rear Holder
[Rear Holder at Lock Position]
Rear Holder
[Rear Holder at Unlock Position]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
32
B–23
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Rear Holder
4.
Locking Clip
Disconnect Terminal from Connector
(a)
Determine the primary locking system from the
charts.
1. Lock Located on terminal
2. Lock Located on connector
3. Method of entry and operation
(b)
Push the terminal gently into the connector and hold
it in this position.
(c)
Insert the special tool into the connector in the
direction shown in the chart.
Move the locking clip to the unlock position and hold
it there.
NOTE: Do not apply excessive force to the terminal.
Do not pry on the terminal with the special tool.
Pull Out
Connector
Wire Harness
”Waterproof Type”
(d)
Terminal
Retainer
(e)
Carefully withdraw the terminal from the connector by
pulling the lead toward the rear of the connector.
NOTE: Do not use too much force. If the terminal
does not come out easily, repeat steps (a) through
(e).
Special
Tool
Locking
Clip
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
33
B–24
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
”Non–Waterproof Type”
Locking Clip
Terminal Retainer
4.8 Type
(f)
0.64 Type
Stopper Portion
Insert the SST into the connector in the direction
shown in the chart.
(g) Insert the SST fully to the tool hole, and push the
terminal lance.
NOTICE:
The terminal has a lance shape, therefore, the
housing may be damaged and the terminal may get
stuck if forcibly pried by wires etc.
Insert the SST so that the stopper portion surface is
facing up.
(h)
Tool Hole
SST
Carefully withdraw the terminal from the connector by
pulling the lead toward the rear of the connector.
NOTICE:
Removal of the terminal from housing cavity will cause
damage to the wire seal section, deteriorating
waterproofing performance. Replace the connector
with a new one.
Terminal Lance
NOTICE:
Do not insert the special tool into the female terminal
box. If you do so, replace the terminal with the new one
whether the terminal is broken or not.
Non–waterproof type TLC housing
NOTICE:
As for Non–waterproof type TLC housing, insert the
special tool into the housing from wire harness side.
Insert the tool from wire harness side
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
34
B–25
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Insulation Displacement Connector Type
Tool Hole
Special
Tool
(a)
Using a special tool, push the terminal lance from the
tool hole.
(b) Carefully withdraw the terminal from the connector by
pulling the lead toward the rear of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not use too much force. If the terminal does not
come out easily, repeat step (a).
Always change the wire with the repair wire, in
accordance with page B–27.
Special
Tool
Terminal Lance
0.64 Type
Special Tool
Tool Hole
Special Tool
Terminal
Lance
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
35
B–26
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
5.
Terminal Deformation
(1) Terminal Bending in Vertical Direction
Inspect the terminal and the connector for
damage.
NOTE:
The locking clip is easily damaged.
Do not reuse the damaged part.
1° or less
1° or less
(2) Terminal Bending in Horizontal Direction
3° or less
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
36
B–27
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
1.
Step 3. Replace the terminal.
Cut the Old Terminal from the Harness.
(a)
Existing
terminal
Use the new wire lead as a guide for proper length.
NOTE: If the length of wire removed is not
approximately the same length as the new piece, the
following problems may develop:
Too short –– tension on the terminal, splice, or
the connector, causing and open circuit.
Too long –– excessive wire near the connector,
may get pinched or abraded, causing a short
circuit.
Cut
New Terminal with lead
HINT: When connecting a wire harness at there or more
spots to the same connector, cut the wire harness as
shown on the left.
2.
Select the correct replacement terminal with
lead, from the supply parts.
3.
Strip insulation from wire on the harness and
replacement terminal lead.
82998–12200
Stripped insulation length (A)
approximately 8 to 11 mm
A
Existing
Harness
A
Start stripping at least 8 mm (0.31 in.) to 11 mm (0.43 in.)
away from the end of the existing harness at vehicle side
and also from the end of the repair wire.
Supplied lead
with New Terminal
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
37
B–28
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the wire when stripping the
wire harness lead. After finishing the operation,
visually inspect the wire. If there is any damage,
perform the operation again.
Good Example:
HINT:
If the wire size is not known, start with largest stripper hole
and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is
removed without nicking or cutting the wire lead.
Bad Example:
(Wire insulation is Stripped at a Slant)
(Wire Lead is Cut)
(Insulation Remains on the Lead)
4.
Wire Harness Outside Diameter
Select Correct Size of Sleeve from the Supply
Parts.
(a)
Insulation
Calipers
Nominal Size of the Wire
Wire Lead
Diameter
Calipers
Measure the diameter of wire by using the measuring
device as following:
When size is based on the outside diameter of the
wire harness
Measure the outside diameter of the wire harness by
placing a measuring device, such as a micrometer or
Vernier Caliper, across the diameter of the insulation on
the lead and taking a reading.
When size is based on the nominal size of the wire
lead.
Measure the diameter of the wire lead by placing a
measuring device, such as a micrometer or Vernier
Caliper, across the diameter of the wire lead and taking
a reading.
HINT:
To calculate the ”nominal size” of wire
Twist Evenly
Nominal size=
3.14 x (Diameter of wire lead)2
4
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
38
B–29
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Small (Red)
Use the table to determine proper sleeve size
Part Number
Medium (Blue)
Nominal size of wire
(Outside Diameter of
wire)
Small
82999–12010
0.3 or less
(1.0 – 0.2 mm)
Medium
82999–12020
0.5 – 1.25
(2.0 – 1.0 mm)
Large
82999–12030
2 or more
(5.0 – 3.0 mm)
Large (Yellow)
NOTE: For details, refer to sleeve size table on item
4 of STEP 1
5.
Good Example
Two Stripped Wires
Sleeve (Blue)
Crimp the Replacement Terminal Lead to the
Harness Lead.
(a)
Overlap the two stripped wire ends inside the sleeve
as illustrated on the left.
Pressure–Contact
Section
Bad Example
Wire in
Short Position
Wire Bend
HINT: You might find it easier if you use a miniature
special tool as a guide as you insert wires into the sleeve.
Special Tool
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
39
B–30
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Crimping
Tool
The crimping tool (AMP Part No. 169060) has color
marks on it. Place the sleeve in the correct section of
the tool according to the color of the sleeve itself.
HINT: For the crimping tool, AMP ”Part No. 169060” is
convenient to use.
Sleeve
Color Marks
(c)
”CLOSE HERE”
With the center of the sleeve correctly placed
between the crimping jaws, squeeze the crimping tool
until either end comes into contact at the section
marked by ”CLOSE HERE”.
Contact
HINT: Check to see that the sleeve and wires are still in
the correct position before closing the crimping tool ends
with steady pressure.
(d)
Pull the joined wires to either end. Make sure that they
are joined firmly by the sleeve.
NOTICE:
If the joined wires come loose the splice is defective,
so replace the sleeve and repeat the procedure.
(e)
”INS” Position
6.
10 mm (0.39 in.)
Crimp both ends of the sleeve with the crimping tool
at the ”INS” position.
Protect Joined Section
Wrap silicon tape around the joins to protect them from
moisture.
NOTE: This job is required in repairs of the engine
compartment, under the floor and other moisture entry
positions.
Three or More Times
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
40
B–31
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Three or More Times
10 mm (0.39 in.)
HINT:
Before starting the operation, thoroughly wipe dirt and
grease off the sections to be joined.
If the adhesive surfaces of two tapes come in contact
they will stick together and will not come apart, so do
not remove the backing film except when using the
tape.
Do not let oil and dust, etc. get on the tape surface.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wrap the remaining part of the sleeve with half of the
tape overlapping at each turn.
(e)
Firmly wrap the tape two times or more about 10 mm
(0.39 in.) from the other end of the sleeve, then wrap
the tape back towards the start again and firmly finish
winding the tape around the center of the sleeve.
Tape overlapping
10 mm (0.39 in.)
Ready about 100 mm (3.94 in.) of silicon tape (Part
No. 08231–00045) and peel off the film.
Stretch the silicon tape until its width is reduced by
half.
About 10 mm (0.39 in.) from the end of the sleeve,
wrap the silicon tape around the sleeve three or more
times while stretching the tape.
Two or More Times
Finish
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
41
B–32
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Step 4. Install the terminal into the connector.
HINT:
(a) Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
(b) Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
(c) Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position, if equipped.
NOTE: If reusing a terminal, check that the locking clip is
still in good condition and in the proper position.
Locking clip
(a)
Special Tool
(b)
If it is on the terminal and not in the proper position,
use the special tool to gently bend the locking clip
back to the original shape.
Check that the other parts of the terminal are in their
original shape.
NOTICE:
Do not readjust or reuse the terminal lance of the
insulation displacement connector type terminal.
Always change the wire with the repair wire.
”Insulation Displacement Connector”
Terminal Lance
Special Tool
NOTICE:
As for 0.64 type terminal, do not adjust the terminal
lance with the special tool.
”0.64 Type”
Terminal Lance
Splash Proof Type Connector
Special Tool
NOTICE:
Removal of the terminal from housing cavity will
cause damage to rubber plug material (the wire
seal), deteriorating waterproofing performance. Be
sure to replace the housing with a new one.
Check the withdrawn terminal for the following if
trying to use it again.
It is free of deformation and damage
It is free of adherents such as rubber plug
material (wire seal)
Replace any deformed terminal.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
42
B–33
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
1.
Wire
Push the Terminal into the Connector until you
hear a ”click”.
NOTE: Not all terminals will give and audible ”click”.
”Click”
”0.64 IDC Type”
”Click”
”Insulation
Displacement
Connector”
”Click”
Good Example:
Bad Example:
NOTICE:
After repairing, never let only one harness stretch.
In cese that it becomes short, do over again using
the repair wire.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
43
B–34
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
2.
Double Locking Type Connector
(with terminal retainer or double locking device)
The connector is fitted with a terminal retainer, or a double
locking device, it is in the temporary lock position at insert
the terminal.
Type A (For 1.0, 1.0II, 1.3, 1.8, 2.3II 4.8 and 8.0 of
Non–Waterproof Type Connector)
Terminal Retainer
(a)
Example:
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
Double Locking
Device
Good
(b)
Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
Bad
∗ Terminal
In Short
Position
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
[Female]
NOTE: If the terminal to locking clip does not lock firmly,
the double locking device cannot lock or terminal retainer
does not lock at full lock position so the terminal backs out
from connector.
Good
Bad
[Male]
∗ Terminal
In Short
Position
(c)
Close terminal retainer or double locking device.
The connector is fitted with a terminal retainer, or a
double locking device, return it to the full lock position.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
44
B–35
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Full Lock Position
[Female]
Full Lock Position
[Female]
Full Lock Position
[Male]
Terminal Retainer
at Temporary
Lock Position
Type B (For 1.8, 2.3, 2.3II, 4.8, 6.3 and 8.0 of Waterproof
Type)
(For Male Connector)
(a)
Terminal Locking
Clip
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
(b)
Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
45
B–36
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTE: If the terminal to locking clip does not lock firmly,
terminal retainer can not lock at full lock position so the
terminal backs out from connector.
Bad Example:
Terminal in Short
Position
Terminal
Locking Clip
Terminal
Retainer
(c)
[Case 1]
”For Case 1”
Push the terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
Full Lock Position
”For Case 2”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the full lock position.
[Case 2]
Full Lock Position
Terminal Retainer
at Temporary Lock
Position
(For Female Connector)
(a)
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
Terminal Locking Clip
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
46
B–37
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Insert the terminal until the locking clip locks firmly.
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
Bad Example:
Terminal in Short
Position
NOTE: If the terminal to locking clip does not lock firmly,
terminal retainer can not lock at full lock position so the
terminal backs out from connector.
Terminal
Locking
Clip
(c)
[Case 1]
”For Case 1”
Push the terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
Full Lock Position
”For Case 2”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the full lock position.
[Case 2]
Full Lock
Position
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
47
B–38
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Type C (For 0.64 Type Connector)
(a)
Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the
temporary lock position.
Temporary Lock Position
(b)
Insert the terminal until the terminal lance locks firmly.
HINT:
1. Pull the terminal back gently to check whether it is
locked correctly.
2. If it cannot be inserted easily, check the terminal and
the connector for damage.
NOTE: If the terminal to terminal lance does not lock
firmly, the double locking device cannot lock or terminal
retainer does not lock at full lock position so the terminal
backs out from connector.
(c)
Close terminal retainer.
The connector is fitted with a terminal retainer, return
it to the full lock position.
Full Lock Position
Type D (For 0.64 Splash Proof Type Connector)
(a)
Verify that the terminal retainer is at unlocked
position.
Terminal Retainer
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
48
B–39
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(b)
Verify that Rear Holder is at unlocked position.
Upper lock
NOTICE:
If Rear holder or wire seal has been removed, replace
it with new one.
Lower lock
(c)
Insert the terminal fully into the housing until it is
locked.
HINT: The terminal has a longer insertion stroke than
conventional ones.
(d)
Set Rear holder to locked position.
Push Rear holder in the direction of arrow until it is
locked.
(e)
Verify that Rear holder is at the specified position.
The rear end of Rear holder is flush with the rear end
of Housing.
Rear Holder
Rear Holder
Housing rear end
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
49
B–40
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Verify that the lock (upper side) is at the specified position
under locked status.
Lock check position, upper
Lock normal engagement position
Incomplete lock engagement
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
50
B–41
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Verify that the lock (lower side) is at the specified position
under the locked status.
Lock check position, lower
Lock normal engagement position
Incomplete lock engagement
(f)
Set Terminal retainer to Lock position.
Insert Special tool into the hole specified in the left
and push Terminal retainer.
Insert Special Tool
Special Tool
hole
(U shaped)
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
51
B–42
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
(g)
Verify that Terminal retainer is inserted to the
specified position.
NOTICE:
If Terminal retainer is stopped at its middle of insertion,
holding wire, push Terminal to help it for full insertion.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
52
B–43
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
SPECIAL EXAMPLE
First fit the section A.
A
Install the lock of the section A first.
A
Install the lock of the retainer and pull the white cover
until you hear a click sound.
B
Install the convex part (A) of the outer part correctly to
the section B of the inner part.
A
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
53
B–44
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Cover
Insulation Displacement Connector
w/ Cover : CLOSE COVER
NOTICE:
Securely lock it
HINT:
When replacing it to a new connector, cut off the fixing band
without leaving it.
Fix Band
UNITE CONNECTOR
Make the projection of the front lock of the upper housing
meet the ditch of the front lock of the lower housing and fix
the rear lock.
NOTICE:
After uniting, securely lock it for not leaving the rear
lock arm deformed.
Make sure that the terminals will not become loose
by pulling the wires lightly.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
54
B–45
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
Insulation Displacement Connector (0.64 Type)
Lock Housing
(a)
Install the upper housing to the lock housing.
NOTICE:
Securely Lock it.
Be careful not to mistake the upper housing and
lower housing when putting together.
Upper Housing
(b)
Upper Housing Attached Lock Housing
Make the projection of the front lock of the upper
housing attached lock housing meet the ditch of the
front lock of the lower housing and fix the rear lock.
NOTICE:
Afteruniting, securely lock it for not leaving the rear
lock arm deformed.
Make sure that the terminals will not become loose
by pulling the wires lightily.
Be careful not to mistake the upper housing and
lower housing when putting together.
Lower
Housing
3.
When properly installed, pulling gently on the
wire lead will prove the terminal is locked in the
connector.
Wire
Pull
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
55
B–46
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
If you working on the waterproof type, make sure that
a rubber plug or a terminal gasket is inserted into the
housing securely.
4.
Secure the Repaired Wire to the Harness
If the wire is not in the conduit, or secured by other means, wrap
vinyl tape around the bundle to keep it together with the other
wires.
5.
Connect Connector
Fit the male connector to the female terminal.
NOTICE:
Do not twist the connector when fitting.
Insert it until fully locked.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
56
B–47
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
Low Fit and Lever Type Connector
[Case 1]
Lever
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
(2)
Push the place indicated by the arrow.
The lock is released and lever is lifted up.
(3)
Lift the lever up until it stops.
an
(4)
Cut the connection of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
Lever
2.
Connect the connector
(1)
Connect the connector in the condition that the lever
is fully lifted up.
HINT: If the lever is locked at the lower position, follow
the procedure [Case 1]. (1) to (3) and lift the lever up fully.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
57
B–48
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
(2)
Hold the connector to prevent it from slip off and push
it down until you hear a click to lock it.
(3)
Confirm that the lever is securely locked.
Lever
Lever is not locked
[Case 2]
Lever
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
(2)
Hold the area indicated by the arrow in the illustration
The lock is released and the lever is lifted up.
(3)
Lift the lever up fully.
(4)
Cut the connection of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
58
B–49
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
2.
Lever
Lever is not locked
Connect the connector
(1)
Connect the connector in the condition that the lever
is fully lifted up.
(2)
Hold the connector to prevent it from slip off and push
it down until you hear a click to lock it.
(3)
Confirm that the lever is securely locked.
[Case 3]
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
(2)
Pick the part indicated in the illustration by fingers.
The lock is released and the lever is lifted up.
(3)
Lift the lever up fully.
Lever
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
59
B–50
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
(4)
Cut the connection of the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
2.
Lever
Connect the connector
(1)
Connect the connector in the condition that the lever
is fully lifted up.
HINT: If the lever is locked at the lower position, follow
the procedure [Case 3]. (1) to (3) and lift the lever up fully.
(2)
Hold the connector to prevent it from slip off and push
it down until you hear a click to lock it.
(3)
Confirm that the lever is securely fitted
Lever is not locked
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
60
B–51
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
Double
locking
device pin
Coil spring
The connector with secondary locking
device
1.
Area used
Wire harness for SRS airbag deployment
Pin
Convex part
Primary locking
device
Lock
2.
Cut the connection of the connector.
(1)
Release the double locking.
(2)
Release the primary locking and separate the
connector.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
3.
Connect the connector
(1)
Lock
Install the primary locking device and connect the
connector.
(2)
Install the double locking device.
NOTICE:
The double locking device can not be installed unless
the primary locking device is installed.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
61
B–52
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
Connector fixed by bolts
1.
Area used
Engine control computer harness
2.
Connector A
(1)
Remove the connector A.
(2) Loose the bolt using a tool like driver until the
connector B can be removed by hand and separate
the connector.
HINT: If the bolt can not be removed, roll it while pulling
forward.
Connector B
3.
Lass than 1mm
Cut the connection of the connector.
(1)
Connector B
Connector A
Bolt
Connection of the connector
Temporarily fit the connector B.
(2) Tighten the bolt by using tool like driver and fit the
connector B completely.
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolt until feeling it lighter. Then confirm
that the width of chink of the connector B is less
than 1mm.
The bolt can be rolled after it is fitted.
If the impact wrench is used, do not let it rolling
more than three seconds. (The housing may be
deformed by generated heat)
Be sure and connect the connector B straight. Do
not incline it while connecting.
(3)
Connect the connector A.
Cross–section of the bolt
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
62
B–53
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–HOW TO INSTALL AND REMOVE SPECIAL CONNECTORS
1.
Cut the connection of the connector
(1)
Push down on locking arm to unlock. Then hold the
back ribs of connector to remove connector.
(2)
Cut the Connection of the connector.
Hold back
rib to pull
connector
Locking Arm
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wire harness to pull it.
2.
back ribs
Connect the Connector
(1)
(2)
Align the direction of locking feature in same direction
and mate the connector holding the back ribs in
straight direction.
Insert it until a lock securely locks, and pull the
connector lightly after the insertion, and confirm that
a lock is enabled.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
63
B–3
TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR REPAIR–TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
TERMINAL REPLACEMENT
These steps must be followed when replacing a terminal.
Step 1. Identify the connector and the terminal type.
B
Step 2. Disconnect the terminal from the connector.
Step 3. Replace the terminal.
Step 4. Install the terminal into the connector.
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
13
C–1
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
0.64
(Double Lock Type)
[Terminal Lance]
CC
0.64
IDC
[Terminal Lance]
1.0
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
1.0II
Non–
waterproof
Type
90980–11223
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
64
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
C–2
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
1.0II
90980–11566
Waterproof
Type
[Housing Lance]
C
1.0III
1.0IV
Non–
waterproof
Type
1.0III
IDC
1.0III
Waterproof
Type
90980–11889
90980–11987
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
90980–12004
90980–11919
[Terminal Lance]
[Terminal Lance]
90980–11863
90980–11856
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
65
C–3
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
1.3
Non–
waterproof
Type
C
1.3
Non–
waterproof
Type
1.3
Non–
waterproof
Type
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
1.3
Waterproof
Type
90980–11188
90980–11189
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
66
C–4
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
1.8
Non–
waterproof
Type
C
1.8
90980–11062
Waterproof
Type
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
1.8II
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
90980–10384
90980–10638
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
2.3
Non–
waterproof
Type
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
67
C–5
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
2.3
Waterproof
Type
C
2.3II
Non–
waterproof
Type
2.3II
90980–12026
IDC
[Terminal Lance]
2.3II
Waterproof
Type
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
68
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
C–6
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
4.8
Non–
waterproof
Type
CC
4.8
Waterproof
Type
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
6.3
Non–
waterproof
Type
6.3
Single
Terminal
[Terminal Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
69
C–7
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
8.0
Non–
waterproof
Type
8.0
Waterproof
Type
BLADE
FUSE
[Housing Lance]
C–Type
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
70
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
C–8
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
6.3
Waterproof
Type
[Housing Lance]
C
6.3
Waterproof
Type
[Housing Lance]
7.7
[Terminal Lance]
[Terminal Lance]
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
7.7
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
71
C–9
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
FOG–
LP
90980–10481
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
C
FTC
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
HEAD
LAMP
90980–10579
Waterproof
Type
[Housing Lance]
HB3
HB4
90980–11095
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
72
C–10
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
LAC
MFPC
[Housing Lance]
MIC
[Terminal Lance]
PULSE
LOCK
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
73
C–11
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
SFPC
[Housing Lance]
SL
[Terminal Lance]
SP
[Housing Lance]
TLC
Non–
waterproof
Type
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
74
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
C–12
TABLE OF HOUSING CROSS SECTION
: Position of the lance
: Direction of lock released
: Direction of the special tool inserted
Type
Male
Female
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
[Housing Lance]
(Double Lock Type)
[Housing Lance]
TLC
Waterproof
Type
TNS
TODC
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
75
E–1
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
List of equivalent for the gold and tin–plated repair wire
Repair Wire Part No.
Tin–plated (Sn)
Gold–plated (Au)
82998–12160 (2.3.M.U)
82998–24050
–12190
(1.8.F.U)
–12300
–12260
(2.3.M.S)
–24070
–12270
(2.3.F.S)
–24080
–12310
(1.0.F.U)
–12320
–12330
(2.3II.M.U)
–12350
–12340
(2.3II.F.U)
–12360
–12430
(2.3II.M.S)
–12450
–12440
(2.3II.F.S)
–12460
–12790
(2.3II.F.S)
–12780
–12670
(1.0III.M.U)
–12680
–12690
(1.0III.F.U)
–12700
–12720
(1.0III.F.S)
–12730
–24020
(1.0II.F.U)
–24110
–24090
(1.8II.M.U)
–24130
E
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
315
E–2
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
* Example : 82998–24050 indicates the gold–plated 82998–12160.
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Terminal
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
E
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10001
X
BHC
M
4
U
–
–
–
10002
X
BHC
F
4
U
–
–
–
10003
X
BHC
M
6
U
–
–
–
10004
X
BHC
F
6
U
–
–
–
10006
X
BHC
F
12
U
–
–
–
10008
X
BHC
F
16
U
–
–
–
10010
X
BHC
F
22
U
–
–
–
10011
X
BHC
M
2
U
–
–
–
10012
X
BHC
F
2
U
–
–
–
10018
X
BHC
M
8
U
–
–
–
10019
X
BHC
F
8
U
–
–
–
10026
X
TODC
M
16
U
12080
–
L,Y
10027
X
–
–
–
12010
–
Y
10028
X
12090
–
L,Y
10029
X
–
–
–
12020
–
Y
10030
X
TODC
M
17
U
12080
–
L,Y
10031
X
TODC
F
17
U
12090
–
L,Y
10032
X
TODC
M
13
U
12080
–
L,Y
10033
X
TODC
F
13
U
12090
–
L,Y
10037
O
MIC
F
17
U
12120
–
L,Y
10038
X
TODC
M
2
U
12080
–
L,Y
10039
X
TODC
F
2
U
12090
–
L,Y
10040
O
TODC
M
5
U
12080
–
L,Y
10041
X
TODC
F
5
U
12090
–
L,Y
10042
X
TODC
M
7
U
12080
–
L,Y
10043
X
TODC
F
7
U
12090
–
L,Y
10044
O
TODC
M
9
U
12080
–
L,Y
10045
O
TODC
F
9
U
12090
–
L,Y
10055
X
TODC
M
3
U
12080
–
L,Y
10056
X
TODC
F
3
U
12090
–
L,Y
10057
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
10061
X
MIC
M
13
U
–
–
–
10062
O
MIC
F
13
U
12120
–
L,Y
10063
X
MIC
M
21
U
–
–
–
10064
X
MIC
F
21
U
12120
–
L,Y
6.3
7.7
TODC
6.3
7.7
M
F
F
6
6
16
6
6
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
316
Memo
PCB
PCB
E–3
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10065
X
TODC
M
15
U
12080
–
L,Y
10066
X
TODC
F
15
U
12090
–
L,Y
10068
X
TODC
M
9
U
–
–
–
10069
X
SL
F
2
U
12130
–
L,Y
10070
O
SL
F
3
U
12130
–
L,Y
10071
O
SL
F
7
U
12130
–
L,Y
10072
X
6.3
F
3
U
12060
12580
Y
10087
X
TODC
M
9
U
12080
–
L,Y
10088
X
6.3
F
3
S
–
–
–
10090
X
6.3
F
1
S
–
–
–
10091
X
6.3
M
2
S
–
–
–
10092
X
6.3
F
2
S
–
–
–
10093
X
6.3
M
3
S
–
–
–
10094
X
6.3
M
4
S
–
–
–
10095
X
6.3
F
4
S
–
–
–
10096
X
TODC
M
6
S
–
–
–
10097
X
TODC
F
6
S
–
–
–
10100
X
TODC
M
16
S
–
–
–
10101
X
TODC
F
16
S
–
–
–
10106
X
TODC
M
9
U
–
–
–
10108
X
SL
F
2
U
12130
–
L,Y
10109
X
SL
F
2
U
12130
–
L,Y
10110
X
6.3
F
3
S
–
–
–
10111
X
FPC
F
3
U
–
–
–
10112
X
FPC
F
8
U
–
–
–
10113
X
FPC
F
8
U
–
–
–
10114
O
7.7
M
1
S
–
–
–
10115
O
7.7
F
1
S
–
–
–
10116
X
6.3
F
2
S
–
–
–
10117
X
TODC
M
5
U
12080
–
L,Y
10119
X
FPC
F
8
U
–
–
–
10121
X
TODC
F
2
U
12090
–
L,Y
10122
X
7.7
M
2
S
–
–
–
10123
X
7.7
F
2
S
–
–
–
10124
X
6.3
F
2
U
–
–
–
10125
X
TODC
M
1
S
–
–
–
10126
X
TODC
M
4
U
12080
–
L,Y
10127
X
TODC
F
4
U
12090
–
L,Y
10130
X
TODC
M
5
U
–
–
–
PCB
E
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
317
E–4
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
E
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10131
X
LAC
M
22
U
12100
–
L,Y
10132
O
LAC
F
13
U
12110
–
L,Y
10133
X
LAC
F
9
U
12110
–
L,Y
10138
X
MIC
M
13
U
–
–
–
10139
X
6.3
M
4
S
–
–
–
10140
X
6.3
F
4
S
–
–
–
10141
X
SL
F
2
U
12130
–
L,Y
10142
X
6.3
F
4
U
–
–
–
10143
X
FPC
F
3
U
–
–
–
10144
X
6.3
M
4
U
–
–
–
10145
X
–
–
–
12010
–
Y
10146
X
–
–
–
12040
–
Y
10147
X
TODC
M
8
U
12080
–
L,Y
10148
X
TODC
F
8
U
12090
–
L,Y
10149
X
TODC
M
12
U
12080
–
L,Y
10150
X
TODC
F
12
U
12090
–
L,Y
10151
X
MIC
M
22
U
–
–
–
10152
O
MIC
F
9
U
12120
–
L,Y
10153
X
2.3
F
12
U
12170
–
L
10154
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10156
O
6.3
M
2
S
–
–
–
10157
O
6.3
F
2
S
–
–
–
10158
X
FPC
F
10
U
–
–
–
10159
X
FPC
F
10
U
–
–
–
10160
X
7.7
M
1
U
12010
–
Y
10161
X
6.3
M
5
S
–
–
–
10162
O
6.3
F
5
S
–
–
–
10163
X
TODC
M
3
U
12080
–
L,Y
10164
X
TODC
F
3
U
12090
–
L,Y
10165
X
7.7
F
1
U
12020
–
Y
10170
X
6.3
M
4
U
12050
–
Y
10171
O
6.3
F
4
U
12060
12580
Y
10172
O
6.3
M
6
U
12050
–
Y
10173
O
6.3
F
6
U
12060
12580
Y
10174
O
6.3
M
8
U
12050
–
Y
10175
O
6.3
F
8
U
12060
12580
Y
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
M
F
M
3
3
2
1
3
3
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
318
Memo
PCB
PCB
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
E–5
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10176
O
6.3
M
10
U
12050
–
Y
10177
O
6.3
F
10
U
12060
12580
Y
10178
O
6.3
M
1
U
12050
–
Y
10179
O
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10182
O
TODC
M
1
U
12080
–
L,Y
10183
O
TODC
F
1
U
12090
–
L,Y
10184
X
TODC
F
2
S
–
–
–
10185
X
7.7
F
2
U
12040
–
Y
10186
X
12050
–
Y
12030
–
Y
10187
X
12050
–
Y
12030
–
Y
10188
X
12050
–
Y
12030
–
Y
10189
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10190
X
EJ
M
3
S
–
–
–
10191
X
EJ
F
3
S
–
–
–
10192
X
EJ
M
2
S
–
–
–
10193
X
EJ
F
2
S
–
–
–
10194
X
TODC
M
6
S
–
–
–
10195
X
TODC
F
6
S
–
–
–
10196
X
6.3
F
4
U
12060
12580
Y
10197
X
TODC
F
1
S
–
–
–
10198
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10199
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10200
X
EJ
M
1
S
–
–
–
10201
X
EJ
F
1
S
–
–
–
10202
X
EJ
M
4
S
–
–
–
10203
X
EJ
F
4
S
–
–
–
10204
X
EJ
M
8
S
–
–
–
10205
X
EJ
F
8
S
–
–
–
10206
X
TODC
M
13
U
–
–
–
10207
X
TODC
F
21
U
12090
–
L,Y
10208
X
–
–
–
12080
–
L,Y
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
6.3
TODC
M
M
M
F
M
F
M
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
8
8
U
U
U
U
S
S
U
Memo
E
PCB
w/ Flange
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
319
E–6
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
E
82998–
6.3
12580
Y
12090
–
L,Y
12050
–
Y
12080
–
L,Y
U
12080
–
L,Y
13
U
12080
–
L,Y
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
X
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10216
O
6.3
F
3
U
12060
12580
Y
10217
X
TODC
M
4
S
–
–
–
10218
X
TODC
F
4
S
–
–
–
10219
X
6.3
M
4
U
12050
–
Y
10220
X
6.3
F
4
S
–
–
–
10221
X
6.3
F
4
U
12060
12580
Y
10222
X
6.3
F
3
U
12060
12580
Y
10223
X
6.3
M
6
U
12050
–
Y
10224
X
6.3
F
6
U
12060
12580
Y
10225
X
6.3
M
8
U
12050
–
Y
10228
X
HEADLAMP
F
3
U
24140
24200
L,Y
10229
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10231
X
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10232
X
6.3
F
3
U
12060
12580
Y
10233
X
12050
–
Y
12080
–
L,Y
10234
X
–
–
–
10235
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10236
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10237
X
6.3
M
4
U
12050
–
Y
10238
X
7.7
F
2
U
12020
–
Y
10239
X
6.3
F
3
S
–
–
–
10240
O
TODC
M
1
S
–
–
–
10241
O
TODC
F
1
S
–
–
–
10242
X
TODC
M
2
S
–
–
–
10243
X
TODC
F
2
S
–
–
–
10244
O
TODC
M
3
S
–
–
–
10209
X
10210
X
10211
X
TODC
M
7
10212
X
TODC
M
10213
O
6.3
10214
O
10215
TODC
6.3
TODC
6.3
TODC
6.3
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
M
M
F
M
F
6
2
6
25
25
3
2
1
2
1
U
U
U
U
S
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
320
Memo
82998–
12060
F
2
Sleeve
Color
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
E–7
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10245
X
TODC
F
3
S
–
–
–
10246
O
6.3
M
1
S
–
–
–
10247
O
6.3
F
1
S
–
–
–
10248
X
6.3
M
3
S
–
–
–
10249
O
6.3
F
3
S
–
–
–
10250
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10251
X
6.3
M
1
U
12050
–
Y
10252
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10253
X
6.3
M
1
U
12050
–
Y
10254
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10255
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
10256
X
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
10257
X
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10258
X
6.3
F
3
U
12060
12580
Y
10259
X
6.3
M
4
U
12050
–
Y
10260
X
6.3
F
4
U
12060
12580
Y
10261
X
6.3
M
5
U
12050
–
Y
10262
X
6.3
F
5
U
12060
12580
Y
10263
X
6.3
M
7
U
12050
–
Y
10264
X
6.3
F
7
U
12060
12580
Y
10265
X
6.3
M
9
U
12050
–
Y
10266
X
6.3
F
9
U
12060
12580
Y
10267
X
MIC
M
9
U
–
–
–
10272
X
LC
M
8
U
–
–
–
10273
X
LC
F
8
U
–
–
–
10274
O
TODC
F
5
U
12090
–
L,Y
10275
X
TODC
M
7
U
12080
–
L,Y
10276
X
6.3
M
5
U
12050
–
Y
10277
X
6.3
M
7
U
12050
–
Y
10278
X
6.3
M
9
U
12050
–
Y
10279
X
TODC
M
8
U
12080
–
L,Y
10280
X
TODC
F
8
U
12090
–
L,Y
10281
X
12050
–
Y
12080
–
L,Y
10282
X
12060
12580
Y
12090
–
L,Y
10283
O
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10284
X
TODC
M
18
U
12080
–
L,Y
10285
X
TODC
F
18
U
12090
–
L,Y
6.3
TODC
6.3
TODC
M
F
3
7
3
7
U
U
Memo
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
E
PCB
w/ Clamp
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
321
E–8
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
E
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10286
X
TODC
M
2
U
12080
–
L,Y
10287
X
TODC
M
16
S
–
–
–
10288
X
TODC
F
16
S
–
–
–
10289
X
LC
M
6
U
–
–
–
10290
X
LC
F
6
U
–
–
–
10291
X
LC
M
14
U
–
–
–
10292
X
LC
F
14
U
–
–
–
10293
X
PULSE
LOCK
M
52
U
–
–
–
10294
O
PULSE
LOCK
F
10
U
12200
–
L,Y
10295
O
PULSE
LOCK
F
18
U
12210
–
L
10296
O
PULSE
LOCK
F
24
U
12210
–
L
10297
X
TODC
M
2
U
12080
–
L,Y
10298
X
TODC
F
2
U
12090
–
L,Y
10299
X
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10300
X
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10301
X
MFPC
F
8
U
12150
–
L
10302
O
MFPC
F
10
U
12150
–
L
10303
O
MFPC
F
12
U
12150
–
L
10304
X
MFPC
F
10
U
12150
–
L
10305
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
10306
X
12050
–
Y
12080
–
L,Y
10307
X
12060
12580
Y
12090
–
L,Y
10308
X
MIC
M
5
U
–
–
–
10309
X
MIC
F
5
U
12120
–
L,Y
10310
X
MIC
M
7
U
–
–
–
10311
X
MIC
F
7
U
12120
–
L,Y
10312
X
TODC
M
6
U
12080
–
L,Y
10313
X
TODC
F
6
U
12090
–
L,Y
10314
X
TODC
M
5
U
12080
–
L,Y
10315
X
MODU
M
26
U
–
–
–
10316
X
MODU
F
26
U
–
–
–
10317
X
12050
–
Y
12080
–
L,Y
6.3
TODC
6.3
TODC
6.3
TODC
M
F
M
2
2
2
2
1
8
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
322
Memo
PCB
w/ Flange
w/ Clamp
PCB
PCB
E–9
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
6.3
Memo
82998–
12060
12580
Y
12090
–
L,Y
12060
12580
Y
12090
–
L,Y
U
12170
–
L
8
U
12170
–
L
F
10
U
12170
–
L
2.3
M
13
U
12160*
–
L
X
2.3
F
13
U
12170
–
L
10325
O
2.3
M
18
U
12160*
–
L
10326
O
2.3
F
18
U
12170
–
L
10327
X
2.3
F
20
U
12170
–
L
10328
X
2.3
F
22
U
12170
–
L
10329
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10330
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10331
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10332
X
7.7
F
1
U
12040
–
Y
10333
X
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
10334
X
6.3
F
6
U
12060
12580
Y
10335
X
6.3
F
6
U
12060
12580
Y
10336
X
6.3
F
8
U
12060
12580
Y
10337
X
6.3
F
11
U
12060
12580
Y
10338
X
6.3
F
11
U
12060
12580
Y
10339
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10340
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10341
X
6.3
F
3
S
12540
–
Y
10342
X
7.7
M
1
U
12030
–
Y
10343
X
7.7
F
1
U
12040
–
Y
10344
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
10345
X
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
10346
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
w/ Clamp
10347
O
6.3
M
3
S
12050
–
Y
w/ Clamp
10348
X
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
10318
X
10319
X
10320
X
2.3
F
2
10321
X
2.3
F
10322
O
2.3
10323
X
10324
TODC
6.3
TODC
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
6.3
7.7
6.3
7.7
F
1
Sleeve
Color
F
M
F
F
F
F
8
1
10
12
2
12
2
14
1
4
1
2
3
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
E
w/o Clamp
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
323
E–10
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
E
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10349
X
PULSE
LOCK
M
30
U
–
–
–
10350
X
PULSE
LOCK
F
18
U
12200
–
L,Y
10351
O
PULSE
LOCK
F
12
U
12200
–
L,Y
10352
X
TODC
F
2
S
–
–
–
10353
O
TODC
F
3
S
–
–
–
10354
X
2.3
M
2
U
12160*
–
L
10355
O
2.3
F
2
U
12170
–
L
10356
O
7.7
M
2
U
12030
–
Y
10357
O
7.7
F
2
U
12040
–
Y
10358
X
6.3
F
8
U
12060
12580
Y
10359
O
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10360
X
2.3
M
8
U
12160*
–
L
10361
X
2.3
M
20
U
12160*
–
L
10362
O
SP
F
2
U
12530
–
L,Y
10363
X
5.2
F
1
U
–
–
–
10364
X
2.3
M
3
U
12160*
–
L
10365
O
2.3
F
3
U
12170
–
L
10366
O
2.3
M
6
U
12160*
–
L
10367
O
2.3
F
6
U
12170
–
L
10368
X
MFPC
F
14
U
12150
–
L
10369
O
MFPC
F
14
U
12150
–
L
10370
X
PULSE
LOCK
M
42
U
–
–
–
10371
O
PULSE
LOCK
F
14
U
12210
–
L
10372
X
MFPC
F
12
U
12150
–
L
10373
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10374
X
7.7
M
2
S
–
–
–
10375
X
2.3
M
10
U
12160*
–
L
10376
X
12520
–
L,Y
12530
–
L,Y
10377
X
SP
F
10
U
12530
–
L,Y
10378
O
MIC
F
4
U
12120
–
L,Y
10379
X
TODC
M
9
S
–
–
–
10380
X
TODC
F
9
S
–
–
–
w/o Clamp
10381
X
TODC
F
9
S
–
–
–
w/ Clamp
7.7
TODC
SP
SP
F
F
2
2
5
5
S
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
324
PCB
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
w/o Clamp
PCB
w/o Flange
E–11
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
6.3
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
–
–
–
12080
–
L,Y
U
12160*
–
L
2
U
12040
–
Y
9
U
12060
12580
Y
12280
–
R
–
–
–
12290
–
R
–
–
–
S
12280
–
R
3
S
12290
–
R
M
1
U
12220
–
L
2.3
F
12
U
12170
–
L
X
TLC
F
1
U
12230
–
L
10399
O
TLC
M
4
U
12220
–
L
10400
X
TLC
F
4
U
12230
–
L
10401
O
TLC
M
6
U
12220
–
L
10402
O
TLC
F
6
U
12230
–
L
10403
X
12220
–
L
12080
–
L,Y
10404
X
12230
–
L
12090
–
L,Y
10405
X
12160*
–
L
12220
–
L
10406
X
12170
–
L
12230
–
L
10407
X
TLC
M
12
U
12220
–
L
10408
X
TLC
F
12
U
12230
–
L
10410
X
6.3
M
3
U
12050
–
Y
10411
X
12050
–
Y
12080
–
L,Y
10412
X
6.3
M
2
S
–
–
–
10413
X
2.3
M
18
U
12160*
–
L
10414
O
2.3
F
6
U
12170
–
L
10415
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10416
X
–
–
–
10382
X
10383
X
10384
O
2.3
M
6
10385
X
7.7
F
10386
X
6.3
F
10392
X
10393
X
10394
X
TLC
M
3
10395
X
TLC
F
10396
X
TLC
10397
X
10398
7.7
6.3
TODC
TLC
TODC
TLC
TODC
TLC
TODC
TLC
TODC
2.3
TLC
2.3
TLC
6.3
TODC
2.3
6.3
2.3
M
M
F
M
F
M
F
M
M
M
2
2
6
3
2
3
2
6
2
6
2
6
6
6
6
2
6
10
2
6
U
U
S
S
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Memo
82998–
12060
F
4
Sleeve
Color
w/ Flange
w/o Flange
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
325
E–12
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
10417
X
2.3
10418
X
–
12160*
–
L
12080
–
L,Y
10419
X
12170
–
L
12090
–
L,Y
10420
X
12170
–
L
10421
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10422
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10423
X
MIC
F
2
U
12120
–
L,Y
10424
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
10425
X
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
10426
X
MIC
F
2
U
12120
–
L,Y
10427
X
2.3
M
10
U
12160*
–
L
10428
O
HEADLAMP
F
3
U
24140
24200
L,Y
10429
X
PULSE
LOCK
M
24
U
–
–
–
10430
X
TLC
M
8
U
12220
–
L
10431
X
TLC
F
8
U
12230
–
L
10432
O
2.3
F
12
U
12170
–
L
10433
X
2.3
M
1
U
12160*
–
L
w/o Clamp
10434
X
2.3
M
1
U
12160*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10435
X
2.3
F
1
U
12170
–
L
10436
X
2.3
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
10437
O
2.3
M
2
U
12160*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10438
X
2.3
M
1
S
12260*
–
L
10439
X
2.3
F
1
S
12270*
12600
L
10440
X
2.3
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
10441
X
2.3
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
10442
X
12180
–
L
12050
–
Y
10443
X
12190*
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10444
X
TLC
M
3
S
12280
–
R
w/o Clamp
10445
X
TODC
M
13
U
–
–
–
PCB
10446
X
12050
–
Y
12030
–
Y
TODC
2.3
TODC
2.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
1.8
6.3
1.8
6.3
6.3
7.7
F
F
F
M
M
F
M
6
2
6
2
3
10
2
12
2
12
3
12
3
4
2
U
82998–
–
M
10
Memo
–
2.3
M
Sleeve
Color
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
326
PCB
w/ Flange
PCB
E–13
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
6.3
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
U
–
–
–
8
U
24170
–
Y
F
11
U
24170
–
Y
6.3
M
7
U
12050
–
Y
6.3
F
7
U
12060
12580
Y
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
U
12220
–
L
U
12230
–
L
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
U
–
–
–
7
U
12230
–
L
15
U
12080
–
L,Y
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
U
12090
–
L,Y
2
U
12170
–
L
M
4
U
12240
–
L
TNS
F
4
U
12250
–
L
X
TNS
M
10
U
12240
–
L
10469
X
TNS
F
10
U
12250
–
L
10470
O
TNS
M
14
U
12240
–
L
10471
O
TNS
F
14
U
12250
–
L
10472
X
12160*
–
L
12240
–
L
10473
X
12170
–
L
12250
–
L
10474
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10475
O
2.3
M
4
S
12260*
–
L
10476
O
2.3
F
4
S
12270*
12600
L
10447
O
10448
X
6.3 II
M
4
10449
X
6.3 II
F
10450
X
6.3 II
10451
X
10452
X
10453
X
10454
X
10455
X
TLC
M
22
10456
X
TLC
F
22
10457
X
10458
X
10459
X
TLC
M
7
10460
X
TLC
F
10461
X
TODC
M
10462
X
10463
O
10464
X
TODC
F
3
10465
X
2.3
F
10466
X
TNS
10467
O
10468
7.7
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
TNS
2.3
TNS
M
F
M
F
M
F
M
F
2
12
4
12
4
19
3
19
3
5
3
5
3
12
9
12
9
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Memo
82998–
12060
F
4
Sleeve
Color
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
327
E–14
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10477
X
2.3
M
6
S
12260*
–
L
10478
X
2.3
F
6
S
12270*
12600
L
10479
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10480
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10481
O
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
10482
X
2.3
F
2
U
12170
–
L
10483
X
2.3
F
3
U
12170
–
L
10484
X
2.3
F
4
U
12170
–
L
10485
X
12160*
–
L
12080
–
L,Y
10486
X
12170
–
L
12090
–
L,Y
10487
O
FTC
F
5
U
12510
–
L,Y
10488
O
FTC
F
5
U
12510
–
L,Y
10489
O
FTC
F
3
U
12510
–
L,Y
10490
O
FTC
F
3
U
12510
–
L,Y
10491
X
MIC
F
2
U
12120
–
L,Y
10492
X
2.3
M
3
S
12260*
–
L
w/o Clamp
10493
X
2.3
M
3
S
12260*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10494
X
2.3
F
3
S
12270*
12600
L
10495
O
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10496
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10497
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10498
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10499
X
6.3
M
1
U
12050
–
Y
10500
X
2.3
M
3
S
12260*
–
L
10501
X
2.3
F
3
S
12270*
12600
L
10502
X
2.3
M
4
U
12160*
–
L
10503
X
2.3
M
4
U
12160*
–
L
10504
O
2.3
F
4
U
12170
–
L
10505
X
2.3
M
6
U
12160*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10506
X
2.3
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
10507
X
2.3
F
14
U
12170
–
L
10508
X
2.3
M
20
U
–
–
–
10509
X
TODC
F
5
U
12090
–
L,Y
10510
X
TNS
M
4
S
–
–
–
10511
X
TNS
F
2
U
12250
–
L
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
TODC
2.3
TODC
M
F
M
F
12
1
12
1
10
6
10
6
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
328
w/ Clamp
PCB
w/o Clamp
E–15
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10512
X
TNS
F
2
U
12250
–
L
10513
O
2.3
M
12
U
12160*
–
L
10514
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10515
X
2.3
F
4
U
12170
–
L
10516
X
2.3
M
10
U
–
–
–
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
12160*
–
L
12030
–
Y
12170
–
L
12040
–
Y
2.3
6.3
F
2.3
10517
X
6.3
2
U
4
F
7.7
2.3
2
2
U
2
4
10518
X
10519
X
10520
X
10521
X
10522
X
10523
X
TNS
F
8
U
12250
–
L
10524
X
TNS
F
12
U
12250
–
L
10525
X
TNS
F
16
U
12250
–
L
10526
O
TNS
F
22
U
12250
–
L
10527
X
TLC
M
10
U
–
–
–
10528
O
TLC
F
10
U
12230
–
L
10529
X
TLC
M
12
U
–
–
–
10530
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10531
X
2.3
M
11
U
12160*
–
L
10532
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10533
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10534
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10535
X
2.3
M
3
U
–
–
–
10536
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10537
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10538
X
2.3
F
14
U
12170
–
L
10539
X
2.3
F
16
U
12170
–
L
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
7.7
2.3
7.7
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
M
M
F
M
F
F
F
F
1
4
1
4
1
15
1
15
1
17
1
8
1
10
1
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
329
E–16
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10542
X
2.3
M
16
U
12160*
–
L
10543
X
2.3
F
16
U
12170
–
L
10544
X
2.3
M
3
U
12160*
–
L
10545
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10546
X
12220
–
L
12260*
–
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
12270*
12600
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
12270*
12600
L
–
–
–
2.3
6.3
TLC
M
M
2.3
10547
X
6.3
2
8
U
U
12
M
7.7
2.3
12
2
S
2
10548
X
10549
X
10550
X
10551
X
6.3
F
4
S
–
–
–
10552
O
TNS
M
22
U
12240
–
L
10553
X
TLC
M
3
S
12280
–
R
10554
O
TLC
F
3
S
12290
–
R
10555
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10556
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10557
X
TLC
M
5
S
12280
–
R
10558
X
TLC
F
5
S
12290
–
R
10559
X
7.7
F
2
U
12040
–
Y
10560
X
2.3
M
16
U
12160*
–
L
10561
X
2.3
F
16
U
12170
–
L
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
6.3
7.7
2.3
6.3
F
F
F
2.3
10562
10563
X
X
6.3
12
2
2
3
2
S
S
S
12
M
2
U
7.7
1
12030
–
Y
2.3
12
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
6.3
F
7.7
2
U
1
10564
X
1.8
M
12
U
12180
–
L
10565
X
1.8
F
12
U
12190*
–
L
10566
X
6.3
M
2
S
–
–
–
10567
X
6.3
F
2
S
12540
–
Y
10568
X
TODC
M
12
S
–
–
–
10569
X
TODC
F
12
S
–
–
–
10570
X
TLC
M
5
S
12280
–
R
10571
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
330
Memo
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
w/o Clamp
E–17
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10572
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10573
O
2.3
M
3
U
12160*
–
L
10574
X
HEADLAMP
F
3
S
24150
24190
L,Y
10575
O
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10576
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10577
O
TLC
M
3
S
12280
–
R
10578
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10579
X
HEADLAMP
F
3
S
24150
24190
L,Y
10580
O
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10581
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10582
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10583
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10584
X
TNS
M
38
U
–
–
–
10585
X
TNS
F
24
U
12250
–
L
10586
X
TNS
M
26
U
–
–
–
10587
O
TNS
F
26
U
12250
–
L
10588
X
TNS
M
20
U
–
–
–
10589
X
TNS
F
20
U
12250
–
L
10590
O
2.3
M
4
S
12260*
–
L
10591
X
2.3
F
4
S
12270*
12600
L
10592
O
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10593
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10594
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10595
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10596
X
2.3
M
6
S
12260*
–
L
10597
X
2.3
F
6
S
12270*
12600
L
10598
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10599
O
TNS
M
26
U
12240
–
L
10600
X
2.3
M
4
U
12160*
–
L
10601
O
2.3
F
4
U
12170
–
L
10602
X
2.3
M
6
U
12160*
–
L
10603
X
2.3
M
6
U
12160*
–
L
10604
X
2.3
F
6
U
12170
–
L
10605
X
2.3
F
6
U
12170
–
L
10606
X
1.8
M
34
U
12180
–
L
10607
X
1.8
F
20
U
12190*
–
L
10608
X
1.8
F
14
U
12190*
–
L
10609
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
331
E–18
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
2.3
Memo
82998–
12170
–
L
12250
–
L
12170
–
L
12250
–
L
12170
–
L
12250
–
L
U
12250
–
L
16
U
12250
–
L
M
7
U
–
–
–
6.3
F
4
S
12540
–
Y
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
U
12060
12580
Y
2
U
12220
–
L
F
2
U
12230
–
L
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10624
X
2.3
F
5
S
12270*
12600
L
10625
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10626
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10627
X
TLC
M
7
S
12280
–
R
10628
X
TLC
F
7
S
12290
–
R
10629
X
2.3
F
3
S
12270*
12600
L
10630
X
2.3
M
18
U
–
–
–
10631
X
2.3
F
5
U
12170
–
L
10632
X
2.3
F
12
U
12170
–
L
10633
X
TLC
F
14
U
12230
–
L
10634
X
TLC
F
14
U
12230
–
L
10635
X
TLC
F
16
U
12230
–
L
10636
X
TLC
F
16
U
12230
–
L
10637
X
2.3
F
2
U
12170
–
L
10638
X
2.3
F
3
U
12170
–
L
10639
X
2.3
M
20
U
12160*
–
L
10640
X
2.3
F
20
U
12170
–
L
10641
X
2.3
M
6
U
12160*
–
L
w/ Flange
10642
X
2.3
M
5
S
–
–
–
PCB
10643
X
2.3
F
6
S
12270*
12600
L
10644
X
2.3
F
5
U
12170
–
L
10610
X
10611
X
10612
X
10613
X
TNS
F
16
10614
X
TNS
F
10615
X
TODC
10616
X
10617
X
10618
X
10619
O
6.3
F
1
10620
X
TLC
M
10621
X
TLC
10622
X
10623
TNS
2.3
TNS
2.3
TNS
6.3
7.7
F
1
Sleeve
Color
F
F
F
4
8
8
10
10
2
1
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
332
PCB
w/ Clamp
PCB
E–19
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10645
O
MFPC
F
4
U
12150
–
L
10646
X
6.3
M
4
S
–
–
–
10647
X
6.3
M
5
S
–
–
–
10648
O
2.3
M
4
S
12260*
–
L
10649
X
2.3
F
4
S
12270*
12600
L
10650
O
2.3
M
6
S
12260*
–
L
10651
X
2.3
F
6
S
12270*
12600
L
10652
X
7.7
F
1
U
12040
–
Y
10653
X
1.8
M
13
S
–
–
–
10654
X
1.8
F
13
S
12620
–
L
10655
X
1.8
M
18
U
–
–
–
10656
X
1.8
F
18
U
12190*
–
L
10657
X
1.8
M
30
U
–
–
–
10658
O
1.8
F
12
U
12190*
–
L
10659
X
FTC
F
5
U
12510
–
L,Y
10660
X
2.3
F
3
U
12170
–
L
10661
X
TNS
M
14
U
–
–
–
10662
X
TNS
M
4
S
–
–
–
10663
X
TNS
F
4
S
–
–
–
Outer
10664
X
TNS
F
4
S
–
–
–
Inner
10665
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10666
X
2.3
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
10667
X
2.3
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
10668
X
2.3
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
10669
O
2.3
F
10
U
12170
–
L
10670
X
2.3
M
6
U
–
–
–
PCB
10671
X
2.3
M
6
U
–
–
–
PCB
10672
O
2.3
F
6
U
12170
–
L
10673
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10674
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10675
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10676
X
TLC
M
7
S
12280
–
R
10677
X
TLC
M
9
S
12280
–
R
10678
X
TLC
F
9
S
12290
–
R
10679
O
2.3
F
2
U
12170
–
L
10680
X
TLC
M
10
U
–
–
–
6.3
7.7
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
F
M
F
4
2
18
1
18
1
U
U
U
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
333
E–20
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10681
X
TNS
M
20
U
–
–
–
10682
X
TNS
M
3
S
–
–
–
10683
X
TNS
F
3
S
–
–
–
10684
X
TNS
F
3
S
–
–
–
10685
X
12270*
12600
L
12540
–
Y
10686
O
12270*
12600
L
12540
–
Y
10687
X
2.3
M
2
U
12160*
–
L
10688
X
5.2
F
1
U
–
–
–
10689
X
2.3
M
3
S
12260*
–
L
10690
X
2.3
F
3
S
12270*
12600
L
10691
X
TNS
M
4
U
–
–
–
10692
X
TNS
F
4
U
12250
–
L
10693
X
2.3
M
10
U
12160*
–
L
10694
X
2.3
M
6
U
12160*
–
L
10695
X
2.3
F
3
S
12270*
12600
L
10696
O
1.8
F
20
U
12190*
–
L
10697
O
1.8
F
14
U
12190*
–
L
10698
X
TLC
M
3
S
12280
–
R
10699
X
TLC
M
10
U
–
–
–
10700
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
10701
X
6.3
F
4
S
12540
–
Y
10702
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10703
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10704
X
6.3
F
3
U
12060
12580
Y
10705
X
6.3
F
1
S
–
–
–
10706
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10707
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
10708
X
6.3
F
3
S
–
–
–
10709
X
12260*
–
L
12280
–
R
10710
X
12270*
12600
L
12290
–
R
10711
O
1.8
F
4
S
12620
–
L
10712
X
2.3
F
5
S
12270*
12600
L
10713
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
TLC
2.3
TLC
6.3
7.7
F
F
M
F
F
2
2
7
2
2
3
2
3
3
2
S
S
S
S
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
334
Memo
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–21
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
2.3
Memo
82998–
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
U
12160*
–
L
4
U
12170
–
L
F
4
U
12170
–
L
6.3
F
5
U
12060
12580
Y
O
TLC
M
10
U
12220
–
L
10720
O
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10721
X
2.3
F
10
U
12170
–
L
10722
X
1.8
M
34
U
12180
–
L
10723
X
2.3
F
11
U
12170
–
L
10724
X
2.3
F
12
U
12170
–
L
10725
X
2.3
F
12
U
12170
–
L
10726
X
PULSE
LOCK
M
30
U
–
–
–
10727
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10728
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10729
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10730
X
2.3
M
17
U
12160*
–
L
10731
X
2.3
F
17
U
12170
–
L
10732
X
TNS
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
10733
X
TNS
M
20
U
–
–
–
PCB
10734
X
1.8
F
2
S
12620
–
L
10735
X
1.8
F
2
S
12620
–
L
10736
X
1.8
F
2
S
12620
–
L
10737
O
1.8
F
2
S
12620
–
L
10738
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10739
X
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
10740
X
12310*
–
L
10741
X
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
10742
X
1.8
M
42
U
–
–
–
10743
O
1.8
F
12
U
12190*
–
L
10744
X
2.3
M
16
U
–
–
–
10714
X
10715
X
2.3
M
14
10716
X
2.3
F
10717
X
2.3
10718
X
10719
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
1.0
1.8
1.0
F
9
Sleeve
Color
F
M
F
M
F
F
F
3
9
2
5
2
5
2
16
48
10
16
16
6
16
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
335
E–22
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10745
X
2.3
M
6
U
–
–
–
10747
X
8.0
F
3
U
12400
–
Y
10748
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10749
O
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
10750
X
TNS
M
26
U
12240
–
L
10751
X
2.3
M
4
S
12260*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10752
X
1.8
M
30
U
–
–
–
PCB
10753
X
2.3
M
16
U
–
–
–
PCB
10758
X
6.3
M
4
U
12050
–
Y
w/ Clamp
10759
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10760
X
–
–
–
12060
12580
Y
10761
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10762
X
12160*
–
L
10763
O
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
10764
O
12310*
–
L
10765
O
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
10766
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10767
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
10768
X
2.3
M
4
S
12260*
–
L
w/o Clamp
10769
X
2.3
M
8
U
–
–
–
PCB
10770
X
PULSE
LOCK
M
24
U
–
–
–
PCB
10771
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10772
X
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
10773
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10774
X
2.3
M
3
S
12260*
–
L
10775
X
TODC
M
9
S
–
–
–
10776
X
TODC
F
9
S
–
–
–
10777
X
TLC
M
3
S
12280
–
R
4.8
2.3 II
6.3
7.7
5.2
6.3
1.8
1.0
2.3
1.8
1.0
1.0
1.8
1.0
6.3
7.7
2.3
6.3
2.3
6.3
1.8
1.0
M
F
F
M
M
F
F
F
F
M
F
M
2
2
2
2
1
1
16
48
5
10
16
16
6
16
4
2
5
2
5
2
16
48
S
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
336
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
w/ Clamp
w/ Clamp
E–23
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
2.3
10778
X
2.3
2
F
6.3
TNS
15
1
12270*
12600
L
12170
–
L
12060
12580
Y
12240
–
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
10780
X
10781
X
MIC
F
11
U
12120
–
L,Y
10782
X
7.7
F
1
U
12040
–
Y
10783
X
7.7
F
2
U
12040
–
Y
10784
X
12060
12580
Y
12040
–
Y
10785
X
2.3
F
6
U
12170
–
L
10786
O
6.3
F
1
U
12070
–
Y
10787
X
2.3
M
3
S
12260*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10788
X
2.3
M
2
S
12260*
–
L
w/ Clamp
10789
O
2.3 II
F
5
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10790
X
2.3 II
M
5
U
–
–
–
10791
X
12160*
–
L
12050
–
Y
10792
O
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10793
X
2.3 II
M
6
U
–
–
–
10794
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10795
O
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10796
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10797
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10798
O
2.3 II
M
8
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10799
O
2.3 II
F
8
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10800
O
2.3 II
M
10
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10801
O
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10802
O
2.3 II
M
12
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10803
O
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10804
O
2.3 II
M
13
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10805
O
2.3 II
F
13
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10806
O
2.3 II
M
14
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10807
O
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10808
O
2.3 II
M
16
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10809
O
2.3 II
F
16
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10810
O
2.3 II
M
20
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10811
O
2.3 II
F
20
U
12340*
–
L,Y
1.0
6.3
7.7
2.3
6.3
F
M
16
48
2
1
2
2
U
82998–
X
M
24
U
Memo
10779
1.8
M
S
Sleeve
Color
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
337
E–24
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
U
12330*
–
L,Y
18
U
12340*
–
L,Y
M
20
U
12330*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
20
U
12340*
–
L,Y
O
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10823
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10824
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10825
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10826
X
TLC
M
9
S
12280
–
R
10827
O
2.3 II
M
15
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10828
O
2.3 II
F
15
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10829
O
2.3 II
M
11
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10830
O
2.3 II
F
11
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10831
X
2.3
F
4
S
12270*
12600
L
10833
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10834
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10835
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10836
O
8.0
M
1
S
12490
–
Y
10837
O
8.0
F
1
S
12500
–
Y
10838
O
8.0
M
2
S
12490
–
Y
10839
O
8.0
F
2
S
12500
–
Y
10840
O
4.8
M
3
S
12470
–
Y
10841
O
4.8
F
3
S
12480
–
Y
10842
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10843
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10844
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
10812
O
10813
O
10814
O
10815
O
10816
O
10817
O
10818
O
2.3 II
M
18
10819
O
2.3 II
F
10820
O
2.3 II
10821
O
10822
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
F
M
F
M
F
F
12
2
12
3
12
3
12
2
18
2
18
2
2
U
U
U
U
U
U
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
338
Memo
82998–
12370
M
2
Sleeve
Color
w/ Clamp
E–25
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10845
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10846
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10847
X
2.3
F
2
S
12270*
12600
L
10848
O
2.3 II
F
16
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10849
X
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10850
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10851
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
10852
O
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10853
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10854
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10855
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10856
O
12330*
–
L,Y
12390
–
Y
10857
O
12340*
–
L,Y
12400
–
Y
10858
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10859
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10860
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10861
O
4.8
M
10
U
12370
–
Y
10862
O
4.8
F
10
U
12380
–
Y
10863
X
2.3 II
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
10864
O
2.3 II
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
10865
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
10866
O
8.0
M
4
U
12390
–
Y
10867
O
8.0
F
4
U
12400
–
Y
10868
O
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10869
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10870
O
2.3 II
M
1
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10871
O
2.3 II
F
1
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10872
O
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
10873
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
10874
O
2.3 II
M
16
U
–
–
–
10875
O
2.3 II
F
22
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10876
O
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
10877
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
8.0
2.3 II
8.0
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
M
F
M
F
18
1
18
1
7
4
7
4
3
5
3
5
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
w/o Clamp
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
339
E–26
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
82998–
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
S
12430*
–
L,Y
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
S
12430*
–
L,Y
8
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
M
1
S
12430*
–
L,Y
F
1
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
S
12430*
–
L,Y
8
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10901
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10902
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10903
O
8.0
F
2
U
12400
–
Y
10904
O
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10878
O
10879
O
10880
O
10881
O
10882
O
10883
O
10884
O
10885
O
10886
O
2.3 II
M
2
10887
O
2.3 II
F
2
10888
O
10889
O
10890
O
2.3 II
M
8
10891
O
2.3 II
F
10892
O
2.3 II
10893
O
2.3 II
10894
O
10895
O
10896
O
2.3 II
M
8
10897
O
2.3 II
F
10898
O
2.3 II
10899
O
10900
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
8.0
4.8
8.0
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
2
Sleeve
Color
F
M
F
M
F
M
F
F
F
M
F
10
2
10
4
20
4
20
1
18
1
18
4
12
4
12
2
3
4
2
2
6
2
6
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
S
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
340
Memo
E–27
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10905
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10906
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10907
O
2.3 II
M
3
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10908
O
2.3 II
F
3
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10909
O
12330*
–
L,Y
12390
–
Y
10910
O
12340*
–
L,Y
12400
–
Y
10911
O
4.8
F
1
U
12380
–
Y
10912
O
4.8
F
1
U
12380
–
Y
10913
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10914
X
6.3
F
1
U
12060
12580
Y
10915
O
4.8
M
2
U
12370
–
Y
10916
O
4.8
F
2
U
12380
–
Y
10917
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10918
X
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
10919
O
12440*
12590
L,Y
10920
O
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
10921
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
10923
O
12440*
12590
L,Y
10924
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10925
O
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
10926
O
4.8
F
8
U
12380
–
Y
10927
O
4.8
M
2
S
12470
–
Y
10928
O
4.8
F
2
S
12480
–
Y
10929
X
1.8
F
4
S
12620
–
L
10930
O
2.3 II
M
7
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10931
O
2.3 II
F
7
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10932
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
10933
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10934
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10935
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
8.0
2.3 II
8.0
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
M
F
F
M
F
F
M
F
F
4
2
4
2
8
18
8
18
3
19
4
19
4
2
16
10
10
16
2
10
U
U
U
U
S
U
U
S
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
341
E–28
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10936
X
2.3 II
M
20
U
–
–
–
PCB
10937
X
2.3 II
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
10938
X
2.3 II
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
10939
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
10940
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
10941
O
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10942
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10943
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10944
O
4.8
M
3
S
12470
–
Y
10945
O
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
10946
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
10947
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10948
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10949
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10950
X
2.3 II
F
88
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10951
X
2.3 II
M
52
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10952
X
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
10953
X
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
10954
X
12370
–
Y
12390
–
Y
10955
X
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
10956
O
8.0
F
3
U
12400
–
Y
10957
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10958
O
8.0
M
2
U
12390
–
Y
10959
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10960
X
MIRROR
F
2
U
–
–
–
10961
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
–
–
–
10962
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10963
O
4.8
M
8
U
12370
–
Y
10964
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10965
O
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
8.0
4.8
8.0
4.8
8.0
4.8
8.0
F
F
M
F
F
F
M
F
2
4
2
2
2
3
2
3
12
8
18
4
18
6
18
6
S
S
S
S
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
342
PCB
E–29
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
10966
O
2.3 II
F
11
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10967
O
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10968
O
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10969
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10970
X
7.7
M
2
S
–
–
–
10971
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
10972
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10973
O
1.8
F
12
U
12190*
–
L
10974
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10975
O
4.8
M
6
U
12370
–
Y
10976
O
4.8
F
6
U
12380
–
Y
10977
O
2.3 II
M
22
U
12330*
–
L,Y
10978
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
10979
X
4.8
M
3
U
12370
–
Y
10980
O
4.8
F
3
U
12380
–
Y
10981
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10982
O
4.8
M
1
S
12470
–
Y
10983
O
4.8
F
1
S
12480
–
Y
10984
X
2.3
M
6
S
12260*
–
L
10985
O
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
10986
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
10987
O
2.3 II
M
6
S
12430*
–
L,Y
10988
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
10989
O
4.8
M
4
S
12470
–
Y
10990
O
4.8
F
4
S
12480
–
Y
10991
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10992
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
10993
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
10994
O
8.0
M
1
U
12390
–
Y
10995
O
8.0
F
1
U
12400
–
Y
10996
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
M
M
M
F
M
M
F
10
32
22
32
16
10
1
4
1
4
18
16
4
6
4
6
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
w/o Clamp
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
343
E–30
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
10997
O
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
10998
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11001
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11002
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11003
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11004
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11005
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11006
O
2.3 II
M
1
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11007
O
2.3 II
F
1
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11008
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11009
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11010
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11011
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11012
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11013
O
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11014
X
6.3
M
2
U
12050
–
Y
11015
O
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11016
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11017
X
1.8
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
11018
X
1.8
M
42
U
–
–
–
PCB
11019
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11020
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11021
O
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
11022
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11023
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11024
O
2.3 II
F
5
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11025
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11026
O
2.3 II
M
1
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11027
O
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11028
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11029
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11030
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11031
O
8.0
M
2
S
12490
–
Y
11032
O
8.0
F
2
S
12500
–
Y
11033
O
2.3 II
M
6
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11034
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11035
O
4.8
M
4
S
12470
–
Y
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
2
3
2
3
S
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
344
w/ Clamp
E–31
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
11036
O
4.8
F
4
S
12480
–
Y
11037
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11038
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11039
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11040
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11041
O
12420
–
L
11042
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11043
O
12420
–
L
11044
O
12470
–
Y
12490
–
Y
11045
O
12480
–
Y
12500
–
Y
11046
X
2.3 II
M
17
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11049
O
2.3 II
F
5
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11050
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11051
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11052
O
1.3
M
3
U
12410
–
L
11053
O
1.3
F
3
U
12420
–
L
11054
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11055
O
12420
–
L
11056
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11057
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11058
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11059
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11060
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11061
X
1.8
F
2
S
12620
–
L
11062
O
1.8
F
2
S
12620
–
L
11063
O
1.3
M
4
S
12630
–
L
Outer
11064
O
1.3
M
4
S
12630
–
L
Inner
11065
O
1.3
F
4
S
12650
–
L
Outer
11066
O
1.3
F
4
S
12650
–
L
Inner
1.8
1.0
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
4.8
8.0
4.8
8.0
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
M
M
F
F
F
M
F
M
F
F
M
F
M
16
18
47
4
11
11
4
25
2
1
2
1
55
8
25
11
4
21
4
21
4
18
16
U
U
U
U
U
S
S
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
345
E–32
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
11067
X
2.3 II
M
6
U
–
–
–
11068
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11069
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11070
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11071
O
2.3 II
F
3
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11072
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11073
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
w/o Clamp
11074
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
w/ Clamp
11075
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11076
X
TNS
M
4
S
–
–
–
11077
O
2.3 II
F
5
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11078
O
2.3 II
M
5
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11079
O
2.3 II
F
3
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11080
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11081
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11082
X
1.0
F
16
U
12310*
–
L
11083
O
1.3
F
11
U
12420
–
L
11084
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11085
O
2.3 II
M
5
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11086
O
2.3 II
M
12
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11087
O
2.3 II
F
12
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11088
O
1.3
M
15
S
12630
–
L
11089
O
1.3
F
15
S
12650
–
L
11090
O
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11091
O
4.8
F
6
U
12380
–
Y
11092
O
4.8
F
8
U
12380
–
Y
11093
O
4.8
M
2
U
12370
–
Y
11094
O
4.8
F
2
U
12380
–
Y
11095
O
HEADLAMP
F
2
S
24150
24190
L,Y
11096
O
HEADLAMP
F
2
S
24150
24190
L,Y
11097
O
2.3 II
M
1
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11098
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11099
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11100
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11101
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11102
O
2.3 II
M
10
U
12330*
–
L,Y
1.8
1.0
1.3
2.3 II
M
M
10
32
30
4
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
346
PCB
w/ Clamp
PCB
PCB
w/ Clamp
E–33
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.8
Memo
82998–
–
–
–
–
–
–
U
–
–
–
PCB
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
M
4
U
–
–
–
PCB
1.3
F
4
U
12420
–
L
X
HEADLAMP
F
3
S
24150
24190
L,Y
11110
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11111
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11113
O
SFPC
F
16
U
24180
–
L
11114
O
SFPC
F
13
U
24180
–
L
11115
O
SFPC
F
13
U
24180
–
L
11116
O
SFPC
F
10
U
24180
–
L
11117
X
2.3 II
M
20
U
–
–
–
11118
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11119
X
–
–
–
11120
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11121
O
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11122
O
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11123
X
2.3 II
M
8
U
–
–
–
PCB
11124
X
1.8
M
30
U
–
–
–
PCB
11125
O
1.3
F
21
U
12420
–
L
11126
O
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
11127
O
–
–
–
11128
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11129
O
12310*
–
L
11130
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11131
O
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11132
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11133
O
1.3
M
25
U
12410
–
L
11134
O
2.3 II
M
8
U
–
–
–
11135
O
4.8
M
4
U
12370
–
Y
11136
O
4.8
F
4
U
12380
–
Y
11103
X
11104
X
2.3 II
M
20
11105
X
2.3 II
M
11106
X
1.3
11107
O
11108
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
1.3
1.3
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
M
8
Sleeve
Color
F
M
M
M
M
M
F
F
18
2
2
21
19
4
2
2
18
16
60
12
2
6
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
347
E–34
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
11137
O
2.3 II
–
L,Y
11138
O
12470
–
Y
12490
–
Y
11139
O
12480
–
Y
12500
–
Y
11140
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11141
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11142
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11143
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11144
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11145
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11146
O
2.3 II
M
1
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11147
O
2.3 II
F
1
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11148
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11149
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11150
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11151
O
2.3 II
F
12
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11152
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11153
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11154
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11155
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11156
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11157
X
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11158
O
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11159
O
12330*
–
L,Y
11160
O
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
11161
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11162
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11163
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11164
X
1.3
M
7
U
–
–
–
11165
O
1.3
F
7
U
12420
–
L
11166
O
2.3 II
F
1
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11167
O
2.3 II
M
16
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11168
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11169
O
1.3
M
3
S
12630
–
L
11170
O
1.3
F
3
S
12650
–
L
8.0
4.8
8.0
1.3
2.3 II
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
M
M
M
F
2
2
2
2
2
21
4
2
1
2
1
2
S
S
S
U
U
S
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
348
Memo
82998–
12430*
4.8
M
Sleeve
Color
PCB
E–35
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11171
O
1.3
M
7
S
12630
–
L
11172
O
1.3
F
7
S
12650
–
L
11173
O
1.3
M
11
S
12630
–
L
11174
O
1.3
F
11
S
12650
–
L
11175
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11176
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11177
O
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11178
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11179
O
1.3
F
15
U
12420
–
L
11180
X
1.3
M
15
U
–
–
–
11181
O
1.3
M
5
S
12630
–
L
11182
O
1.3
F
5
S
12650
–
L
11183
O
8.0
M
1
S
12490
–
Y
11184
O
8.0
F
1
S
12500
–
Y
11186
O
1.3
M
4
U
12410
–
L
11187
O
1.3
F
4
U
12420
–
L
11188
O
1.3
M
2
S
12630
–
L
11189
O
1.3
F
2
S
12650
–
L
11190
O
2.3 II
F
8
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11191
O
1.3
M
9
S
12630
–
L
11192
O
1.3
F
9
S
12650
–
L
11193
O
2.3 II
M
6
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11194
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
22
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
22
U
12340*
–
L,Y
1
S
24160
–
L
2.3 II
11195
O
2.3 II
F
6.3 II
11196
O
2.3 II
M
6
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11197
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11198
X
1.3
M
13
U
–
–
–
11199
X
1.3
F
13
U
12420
–
L
11200
X
1.3
M
11
U
12410
–
L
11201
X
1.3
M
15
U
12410
–
L
11202
X
1.3
M
17
U
12410
–
L
11203
X
1.3
F
17
U
12420
–
L
11204
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11205
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11206
X
12410
–
L
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
M
F
M
15
4
15
4
21
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
349
E–36
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
11207
O
2.3 II
12590
L,Y
11208
O
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11211
O
1.3
M
2
U
12410
–
L
11212
O
1.3
F
2
U
12420
–
L
11213
X
1.0
M
120
S
–
–
–
11214
O
1.0
F
80
S
–
–
–
11215
O
1.0
F
40
S
–
–
–
11216
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11217
X
1.0 II
M
100
U
–
–
–
11218
O
1.0 II
F
28
U
24020*
–
L
11219
O
1.0 II
F
16
U
24020*
–
L
11220
O
1.0 II
F
22
U
24020*
–
L
11221
O
1.0 II
F
34
U
24020*
–
L
24010
–
L
24030
–
L,Y
2.3 II
M
1.0 II
11222
11223
11224
11225
11226
O
O
O
O
O
1.8 II
2
19
4
S
U
18
M
14
U
1.8 II
14
24090
–
L,Y
1.0 II
12
24010
–
L
24030
–
L,Y
1.8 II
M
6
U
1.8 II
6
24090
–
L,Y
1.0 II
12
24020*
–
L
24040
–
L,Y
1.8 II
F
6
U
1.8 II
6
24100*
–
L,Y
1.0 II
6
24020*
–
L
24040
–
L,Y
1.8 II
F
8
U
1.8 II
8
24100*
–
L,Y
1.0 II
12
24020*
–
L
24040
–
L,Y
24100*
–
L,Y
12340*
–
L,Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
1.8 II
F
1.8 II
2.3 II
6
U
6
11228
O
11229
X
2.3 II
M
3
U
–
–
–
PCB
11230
X
2.3 II
M
5
U
–
–
–
PCB
11231
O
2.3 II
F
10
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11232
O
2.3 II
F
5
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11233
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
1.0
1.8
1.0
M
18
16
4
22
U
PCB
O
M
2
PCB
11227
1.8
F
Memo
82998–
12440*
1.3
F
Sleeve
Color
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
350
PCB
PCB
E–37
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.8
Memo
82998–
12190*
–
L
12310*
–
L
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
2
S
12470
–
Y
F
2
S
12480
–
Y
F
22
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
12430*
–
L,Y
12490
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
12500
–
Y
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11248
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11249
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11250
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11251
X
2.3 II
F
3
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11252
O
2.3 II
F
1
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11253
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11254
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11255
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11256
X
1.3
M
11
S
12630
–
L
11257
X
1.3
F
11
S
12650
–
L
11258
O
4.8
M
1
U
12370
–
Y
11259
O
4.8
F
1
U
12380
–
Y
11260
X
2.3 II
F
20
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11261
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11262
X
1.3
M
4
S
12630
–
L
Outer
11263
X
1.3
M
15
U
–
–
–
PCB
11264
O
1.3
F
15
U
12420
–
L
11265
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
11234
X
11235
O
2.3 II
F
2
11236
X
4.8
M
11237
O
4.8
11238
X
2.3 II
11239
O
11240
O
11241
O
11242
O
11243
O
2.3 II
F
1
11244
O
2.3 II
M
11245
O
2.3 II
11246
O
11247
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
8.0
2.3 II
8.0
1.0 III
1.0 III
F
4
Sleeve
Color
M
F
M
F
M
22
3
8
3
8
6
2
6
2
5
52
U
S
S
S
S
U
w/ Clamp
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
351
E–38
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.8
–
–
–
–
–
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
S
12430*
–
L,Y
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
M
1
S
12430*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
1
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
O
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11273
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11274
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11276
X
4.8
F
10
U
12380
–
Y
11277
X
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11278
O
12340*
–
L,Y
11279
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11280
O
12340*
–
L,Y
11281
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11282
X
12440*
12590
L,Y
11283
X
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11284
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11285
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11286
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11287
X
12430*
–
L,Y
12490
–
Y
11288
X
12440*
12590
L,Y
12500
–
Y
11289
O
2.3 II
M
6
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11290
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11291
O
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11292
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11293
X
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11294
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11295
O
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11296
X
2.3 II
F
3
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11297
X
4.8
F
6
U
12380
–
Y
11266
X
11267
X
11268
X
2.3 II
M
4
11269
X
2.3 II
F
11270
O
2.3 II
11271
O
11272
1.0
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.0 IV
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
8.0
2.3 II
8.0
M
F
F
F
32
2
4
1
8
2
2
6
U
S
U
U
U
F
6
U
M
98
24
U
F
1
S
F
M
F
2
2
2
2
2
2
S
S
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
352
Memo
82998–
–
M
10
Sleeve
Color
PCB
PCB
w/ Clamp
E–39
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11298
X
2.3 II
M
3
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11299
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11300
O
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11301
X
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11302
X
4.8
F
9
U
12380
–
Y
11303
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11304
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11305
X
1.3
M
2
U
12410
–
L
11306
X
1.3
F
2
U
12420
–
L
11307
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11308
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11309
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11310
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11311
O
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11312
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
11313
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11314
O
HEADLAMP
F
3
U
24140
24200
L,Y
11315
X
2.3 II
F
1
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11316
X
12330*
–
L,Y
–
–
–
11317
O
2.3 II
F
5
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11318
X
1.3
M
5
U
–
–
–
11319
O
1.3
F
5
U
12420
–
L
11320
X
1.3
M
8
U
–
–
–
11321
X
1.3
F
8
U
12420
–
L
11322
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
22
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
22
U
12340*
–
L,Y
1
S
24160
–
L
4.8
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
2.3 II
6.3 II
F
M
F
M
F
M
2.3 II
11323
O
2.3 II
F
6.3 II
2
2
15
4
15
4
13
4
13
4
20
1
S
U
U
U
U
U
Memo
w/ Clamp
PCB
PCB
PCB
11324
X
2.3 II
M
16
U
–
–
–
PCB
11325
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
11326
X
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11327
X
2.3 II
M
5
U
12330*
–
L,Y
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
353
E–40
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
11328
X
1.3
M
4
S
12630
–
L
Inner
11329
X
1.3
F
4
S
12650
–
L
Outer
11330
X
1.3
F
4
S
12650
–
L
Inner
11331
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
11332
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11333
X
12180
–
L
–
–
–
11334
X
1.3
M
17
U
12410
–
L
11335
X
1.3
F
17
U
12420
–
L
11336
X
1.3
F
3
U
12420
–
L
11337
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
11338
X
1.0
M
80
S
–
–
–
11339
X
1.3
M
7
U
–
–
–
11340
X
1.3
F
7
U
12420
–
L
11341
X
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11342
X
1.0
M
40
U
–
–
–
11343
X
1.0
M
28
U
–
–
–
11344
X
1.0
M
16
U
–
–
–
11345
X
1.0
M
22
U
–
–
–
11346
X
1.0
M
34
U
–
–
–
11347
X
LA
F
40
U
–
–
–
11348
O
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11349
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11350
X
1.3
F
13
U
12420
–
L
11351
X
2.3 II
M
16
U
–
–
–
11352
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11353
X
2.3 II
M
8
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11354
X
2.3 II
F
8
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12390
–
Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
4.8
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
1.0 II
1.8 II
F
M
M
4.8
11355
X
2.3 II
X
11357
X
11359
X
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
8
4
22
60
16
S
U
U
4
M
8.0
11356
2
38
U
1
M
M
F
4
24
27
4
51
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
354
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–41
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
11360
X
2.3 II
4
F
8.0
4.8
38
U
1
4
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12400
–
Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
X
11362
X
11363
O
11364
O
11365
X
11366
X
11367
X
1.3
M
2
U
12410
–
L
11368
O
1.3
M
2
U
12410
–
L
11369
O
1.3
F
2
U
12420
–
L
11370
X
2.3 II
M
15
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11371
X
2.3 II
M
15
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11372
X
2.3 II
F
15
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11373
X
2.3 II
M
25
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11374
X
2.3 II
M
25
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11375
X
2.3 II
F
25
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11376
X
1.3
M
19
U
12410
–
L
11377
X
1.3
F
19
U
12420
–
L
11378
X
1.3
M
21
U
12410
–
L
11379
X
1.3
F
21
U
12420
–
L
11380
X
1.3
M
23
U
12410
–
L
11381
X
1.3
F
23
U
12420
–
L
11382
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
11383
X
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11384
X
1.3
M
13
U
–
–
–
11385
X
8.0
M
3
U
12390
–
Y
11386
X
8.0
F
2
U
12400
–
Y
11387
X
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
11388
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11389
X
1.3
M
8
U
–
–
–
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.0 IV
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
8.0
F
F
M
M
F
F
4
4
4
1
81
24
2
8
2
8
1
2
U
U
S
U
U
U
U
Memo
82998–
11361
2.3 II
M
Sleeve
Color
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
355
E–42
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.0 II
–
L
24100*
–
L,Y
24020*
–
L
24020*
–
L
24100*
–
L,Y
U
12410
–
L
13
U
12420
–
L
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
X
2.3 II
F
8
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11398
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11399
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11400
O
4.8
F
1
S
12480
–
Y
11401
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11402
X
1.3
M
7
U
–
–
–
11403
X
1.3
M
25
U
12410
–
L
11404
X
1.3
F
25
U
12420
–
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
24020*
–
L
24100*
–
L,Y
11390
O
11391
O
11392
O
11393
X
1.3
M
13
11394
X
1.3
F
11395
X
2.3 II
11396
X
11397
1.8 II
1.0 II
1.0 II
1.8 II
F
F
1.8
11405
X
1.0 II
16
16
6
U
U
12
M
1.8 II
1.0 II
10
U
32
U
10
22
11406
X
11407
X
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11408
O
1.0 II
F
12
U
24020*
–
L
11409
X
4.8
M
2
S
12470
–
Y
11410
O
4.8
F
2
S
12480
–
Y
11411
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11412
O
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
11413
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11414
X
SL
F
3
S
–
–
–
11415
X
2.3 II
M
16
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11416
X
2.3 II
F
16
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11417
O
2.3 II
F
17
U
12340*
–
L,Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
1.8 II
1.3
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
F
M
M
F
1.8
11418
X
1.0 II
1.8 II
4
21
4
3
2
3
2
U
U
S
S
12
M
16
10
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
356
Memo
82998–
24020*
F
16
Sleeve
Color
PCB
PCB
w/o Clamp
PCB
PCB
E–43
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11419
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
–
–
–
11420
X
2.3
F
17
U
12170
–
L
11421
O
12690*
–
L
12740
–
L
11422
X
24020*
–
L
24100*
–
L,Y
11423
O
24020*
–
L
24100*
–
L,Y
11424
O
1.8 II
F
12
U
24100*
–
L,Y
11425
X
1.0 II
F
16
U
24020*
–
L
11426
X
2.3 II
M
4
U
–
–
–
11427
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11428
O
2.3 II
F
1
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11429
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
1.0 III
1.0 IV
1.0 II
1.8 II
1.0 II
1.8 II
F
F
F
4.8
11430
11431
X
X
2.3 II
20
11
18
8
16
10
U
U
U
4
M
40
U
8.0
5
12390
–
Y
4.8
4
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12400
–
Y
24100*
–
L,Y
24040
–
L,Y
24100*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
8.0
1.8 II
40
U
5
11432
X
11433
O
11434
X
C–TYPE
M
16
U
12560
–
L
11435
X
C–TYPE
F
16
U
12570
–
L
11436
O
1.3
F
2
U
12420
–
L
11437
X
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11438
X
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
11439
X
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11440
X
2.3 II
M
20
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11441
X
2.3 II
F
20
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11442
X
2.3 II
M
20
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11443
X
2.3 II
F
20
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11444
O
2.3 II
M
16
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11445
X
2.3 II
F
16
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11447
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11448
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
1.8 II
1.8 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
F
F
M
F
20
14
14
3
5
3
5
U
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
357
E–44
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11449
X
1.3
M
10
U
–
–
–
11450
O
1.3
F
10
U
12420
–
L
11451
O
2.3 II
F
3
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11452
X
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11453
X
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11459
X
2.3 II
F
8
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11460
X
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
11461
X
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11462
X
1.3
M
16
S
12630
–
L
11463
X
1.3
F
16
S
12650
–
L
11464
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
11465
X
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11466
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11467
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11468
X
1.3
M
22
U
–
–
–
11469
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11470
X
1.3
M
3
U
12410
–
L
11471
O
1.3
F
3
U
12420
–
L
11472
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11473
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11474
X
1.3
M
12
U
–
–
–
11475
O
1.3
F
12
U
12420
–
L
11476
O
12690*
–
L
12740
–
L
11477
X
LAC
M
22
U
12100
–
L,Y
11478
X
LAC
F
13
U
12110
–
L,Y
11479
X
LAC
F
9
U
12110
–
L,Y
11483
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11484
X
12330*
–
L,Y
12390
–
Y
11485
X
12340*
–
L,Y
12400
–
Y
11486
O
12430*
–
L,Y
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.0 IV
1.3
2.3 II
2.3 II
8.0
2.3 II
8.0
2.3 II
M
F
F
M
M
F
M
M
F
M
2
6
2
6
16
4
30
4
21
4
17
7
21
4
1
2
1
2
2
S
S
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
358
Memo
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–45
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11487
X
1.3
M
6
U
12410
–
L
11488
X
1.3
F
6
U
12420
–
L
11489
X
1.3
M
3
U
12410
–
L
11490
O
1.3
F
3
U
12420
–
L
11491
X
6.3
F
3
S
12540
–
Y
11492
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11493
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11494
O
1.3
F
4
U
12420
–
L
11495
X
1.3
F
4
U
12420
–
L
11496
X
1.3
M
18
U
–
–
–
11497
X
1.3
F
18
U
12420
–
L
11498
X
1.3
M
20
U
12410
–
L
11499
X
1.3
F
20
U
12420
–
L
11500
X
1.3
M
12
U
12410
–
L
11501
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11502
O
1.3
F
22
U
12420
–
L
11503
O
1.3
M
22
U
12410
–
L
11504
O
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11505
X
1.3
M
17
U
12410
–
L
11506
X
1.3
F
17
U
12420
–
L
11507
X
1.3
M
64
U
–
–
–
11508
X
1.3
F
40
U
12420
–
L
11509
X
1.3
F
24
U
12420
–
L
11510
X
1.3
M
14
U
–
–
–
11511
X
1.3
F
14
U
12420
–
L
11512
X
ABS
F
2
U
–
–
–
11514
X
ABS
F
32
U
–
–
–
11517
X
ABS
F
6
S
–
–
–
11519
X
ABS
F
2
S
–
–
–
11520
X
ABS
F
2
S
–
–
–
11522
X
ABS
F
4
S
–
–
–
11524
X
ABS
F
12
U
–
–
–
11526
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
M
M
M
4
2
4
2
16
4
16
4
2
8
U
U
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
359
E–46
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
Memo
82998–
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
U
12330*
–
L,Y
7
U
12340*
–
L,Y
M
12
U
12330*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
O
1.3
M
8
U
12410
–
L
11533
O
1.3
F
8
U
12420
–
L
11534
O
2.3 II
M
9
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11535
O
2.3 II
F
9
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11536
O
2.3 II
M
10
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11537
O
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11538
O
2.3 II
M
11
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11539
O
2.3 II
F
11
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11540
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11541
O
2.3 II
M
13
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11542
O
2.3 II
F
13
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11543
X
2.3 II
M
9
U
–
–
–
PCB
11544
O
1.3
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
11545
X
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11546
X
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
11547
X
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11548
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11549
X
24030
–
L,Y
24090
–
L,Y
11550
X
1.8
M
12
U
–
–
–
11551
X
4.8
M
8
U
12370
–
Y
11552
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11553
X
–
–
–
11554
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11555
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11556
O
1.3
F
14
U
12420
–
L
11557
X
1.3
M
60
U
–
–
–
11527
O
11528
O
2.3 II
M
7
11529
O
2.3 II
F
11530
O
2.3 II
11531
O
11532
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
1.8 II
1.8 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
F
2
Sleeve
Color
M
F
M
M
F
M
M
F
8
4
12
4
12
8
18
34
34
16
22
5
16
22
16
22
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
360
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–47
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
11558
X
1.3
11559
X
L
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11560
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11561
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11562
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11563
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11564
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11565
O
24020*
–
L
24100*
–
L,Y
11566
X
1.0 II
F
40
S
24060
–
L
11567
X
1.0 II
M
40
S
–
–
–
11568
X
2.3 II
M
13
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11569
X
12440*
12590
L,Y
12500
–
Y
11570
O
1.3
M
19
U
12410
–
L
11571
O
1.3
F
19
U
12420
–
L
11572
O
1.3
M
52
U
–
–
–
11573
O
1.3
M
16
U
12410
–
L
11574
O
1.3
F
16
U
12420
–
L
11575
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11576
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11577
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11578
O
1.0
M
100
U
–
–
–
11579
O
8.0
F
2
U
12400
–
Y
11580
X
1.3
M
10
U
12410
–
L
11581
X
1.3
F
10
U
12420
–
L
11582
X
1.3
M
8
U
12410
–
L
11583
O
4.8
F
6
U
12380
–
Y
11585
X
2.3 II
M
16
U
–
–
–
PCB
11586
X
1.0 III
F
17
U
12640
–
L
IDC
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
1.0 II
1.8 II
1.0 II
1.8 II
2.3 II
8.0
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
F
M
F
M
M
F
F
M
M
M
8
9
8
9
6
10
6
10
10
32
26
16
10
6
2
2
22
32
16
48
16
60
U
82998–
–
M
20
Memo
12420
1.3
F
Sleeve
Color
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
S
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
361
E–48
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11587
O
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11588
X
1.3
M
8
U
12410
–
L
11589
X
1.3
M
2
U
–
–
–
11590
X
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
11591
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11592
O
2.3 II
F
8
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11593
X
2.3 II
F
8
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11594
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11595
O
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11596
O
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
11597
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11598
O
2.3 II
M
5
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11599
O
2.3 II
F
5
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
M
F
F
F
M
M
4.8
11600
11601
O
X
2.3 II
8
6
8
6
10
8
10
8
2
8
10
32
U
U
U
U
U
U
3
M
12
S
8.0
2
12490
–
Y
4.8
3
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
12500
–
Y
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
F
8.0
4.8
12
S
2
2
11602
X
11603
X
11604
O
11605
X
11606
X
11607
X
2.3 II
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11608
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11609
X
12470
–
Y
12430*
–
L,Y
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
F
M
F
M
3
2
3
13
2
2
2
2
3
8
U
U
U
U
U
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
362
Memo
PCB
PCB
E–49
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
12410
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
U
12380
–
Y
6
U
12420
–
L
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
F
40
U
12420
–
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
U
–
–
–
PCB
22
U
–
–
–
PCB
M
3
S
12430*
–
L,Y
M
8
U
12410
–
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
X
11611
X
11612
X
11613
O
11614
X
11615
O
4.8
F
8
11616
O
1.3
F
11617
X
2.3 II
11618
X
1.3
11619
X
11620
X
1.3
M
3
11621
X
1.3
M
11622
O
2.3 II
11623
O
1.3
11624
X
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.0 II
1.8 II
1.3
2.3 II
F
F
M
F
M
M
1.3
11625
X
4.8
82998–
–
11610
2.3 II
Memo
12370
M
4
Sleeve
Color
22
4
22
3
8
8
2
8
2
16
18
6
10
U
U
S
U
U
U
U
5
M
2.3 II
2
U
17
PCB
PCB
PCB
11626
X
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11627
X
1.3
M
20
U
12410
–
L
11628
O
1.3
F
22
U
12420
–
L
11629
O
1.3
M
8
U
–
–
–
11630
O
1.3
F
8
U
12420
–
L
11631
O
12370
–
Y
12330*
–
L,Y
11632
X
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11633
X
1.3
F
8
U
12420
–
L
11634
X
1.3
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
11635
X
1.3
M
13
U
–
–
–
PCB
11636
X
1.3
M
8
U
–
–
–
PCB
11637
O
1.0 III
F
28
U
12690*
–
L
4.8
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
M
F
6
20
6
20
U
U
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
363
E–50
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.0 III
–
L
12740
–
L
–
–
–
–
4
S
24160
–
L
M
10
U
–
–
–
F
10
U
12420
–
L
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
U
12420
–
L
U
12340*
–
L,Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
14
U
12410
–
L
M
2
U
12390
–
Y
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
O
1.3
F
10
U
12420
–
L
11658
O
2.3 II
F
10
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11659
O
HEADLAMP
F
2
S
24150
24190
L,Y
11660
O
HEADLAMP
F
2
S
24150
24190
L,Y
11661
O
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11662
X
8.0
F
4
U
12400
–
Y
11663
X
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11664
X
2.3 II
F
12
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11665
O
OBD II
F
16
U
–
–
–
11666
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11638
O
11639
X
–
–
–
11640
X
6.3 II
F
11641
O
1.3
11642
O
1.3
11643
O
11644
X
11645
X
11646
X
11647
X
11648
X
1.3
F
16
11649
O
2.3 II
F
12
11650
X
11651
X
11652
X
11653
O
2.3 II
F
10
11654
O
1.3
M
11655
O
8.0
11656
O
11657
1.0 IV
4.8
2.3 II
1.3
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.8
1.0
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
F
M
M
M
M
M
M
F
6
2
7
14
60
10
36
16
20
16
22
32
8
6
10
6
U
S
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
364
Memo
82998–
12690*
F
16
Sleeve
Color
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–51
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
Memo
82998–
12380
–
Y
12400
–
Y
U
12330*
–
L,Y
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
U
12400
–
Y
15
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
M
16
U
12410
–
L
1.3
F
16
U
12420
–
L
X
1.3
M
16
U
12410
–
L
11683
X
1.3
F
16
U
12420
–
L
11684
O
8.0
F
2
U
12400
–
Y
11685
O
8.0
F
3
U
12400
–
Y
11686
O
4.8
F
8
U
12380
–
Y
11687
X
6.3
F
2
U
12060
12580
Y
11688
X
1.3
M
5
S
12630
–
L
11689
X
1.3
M
5
S
12630
–
L
11690
X
1.3
F
5
S
12650
–
L
Outer
11691
X
1.3
F
5
S
12650
–
L
Inner
11693
X
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11694
X
2.3 II
M
13
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11695
X
2.3 II
F
13
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11696
X
1.5
M
6
U
–
–
–
11697
X
1.5
F
6
U
–
–
–
11698
O
1.3
F
12
S
12650
–
L
11700
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11701
O
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11703
X
2.3 II
F
1
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11709
X
2.3 II
M
9
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11710
X
2.3 II
F
9
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11714
X
2.3 II
F
13
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11716
X
12420
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11720
X
12340*
–
L,Y
11667
X
11669
X
2.3 II
M
27
11670
X
2.3 II
F
27
11671
O
11672
X
11676
X
8.0
F
4
11677
X
2.3 II
F
11680
X
1.3
11681
X
11682
8.0
1.3
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
1.0 II
1.8 II
4.8
2.3 II
1.3
2.3 II
2.3 II
F
1
Sleeve
Color
F
F
M
F
F
F
2
8
9
8
9
32
10
4
4
10
8
12
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
365
E–52
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11724
X
2.3 II
M
2
U
12350*
–
L,Y
11731
X
HEADLAMP
F
3
U
24140
24200
L,Y
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
1.8
11733
O
1.0
1.0 II
22
M
1.8 II
16
16
U
22
Memo
PCB
11735
X
2.3 II
M
2
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11736
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11737
X
2.3 II
M
1
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11738
X
2.3 II
F
1
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11739
X
2.3 II
M
7
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11740
X
2.3 II
F
7
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11742
O
4.8
F
4
U
12380
–
Y
11743
X
1.3
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
11744
X
1.3
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
11745
X
1.3
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
11746
X
1.3
M
22
U
–
–
–
PCB
11747
X
2.3 II
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
11748
X
2.3 II
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
11749
X
2.3 II
M
20
U
–
–
–
PCB
11750
X
2.3 II
M
20
U
–
–
–
PCB
11751
X
2.3 II
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
11752
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
11753
X
2.3 II
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
11757
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11763
X
2.3 II
M
3
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11764
O
2.3 II
F
3
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11765
X
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11766
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11767
X
2.3 II
M
1
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11769
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11771
X
12380
–
Y
12340*
–
L,Y
11772
X
2.3 II
F
5
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11773
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11774
X
9.5
M
1
U
–
–
–
11775
X
9.5
F
1
U
–
–
–
11777
X
1.3
F
3
U
12420
–
L
4.8
2.3 II
F
2
2
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
366
E–53
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
82998–
11778
O
4.8
F
6
U
12380
–
Y
11779
O
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11780
O
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11781
X
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11782
X
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11784
O
12480
–
Y
12440*
12590
L,Y
11785
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11786
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11787
X
–
–
–
11788
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11789
X
1.0 III
M
2
S
12710
–
L
11790
X
1.0 III
F
2
S
12720*
–
L
11791
X
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11792
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11794
X
VH
F
7
U
–
–
–
11797
X
2.3 II
F
5
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11799
X
4.8
F
4
U
12380
–
Y
11800
X
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11805
X
2.3 II
F
14
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11809
X
4.8
M
4
U
12370
–
Y
11812
X
2.3 II
M
4
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11814
X
2.3 II
M
6
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11817
X
2.3 II
F
10
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11820
X
2.3 II
F
6
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11823
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11824
X
8.0
F
2
U
12400
–
Y
11827
X
2.3 II
F
13
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11839
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11840
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11841
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11842
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11843
X
2.3 II
M
5
U
12330*
–
L,Y
11847
X
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
11848
X
2.3 II
F
13
U
12340*
–
L,Y
4.8
2.3 II
1.0 J
1.8 J
1.0 J
1.8 J
1.0 J
1.0 J
1.8 J
F
M
F
F
F
2
7
48
16
16
10
16
16
6
S
U
U
U
U
Memo
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
367
E–54
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
4.8
–
Y
–
12790*
L,Y
U
12060
12580
Y
2
S
12710
–
L
F
2
S
12720*
–
L
1.0 III
F
4
S
12720*
–
L
O
2.3 II
F
6
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11859
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11860
X
2.3 II
F
3
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11861
X
12480
–
Y
–
–
–
11862
O
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
11863
X
1.0 III
M
2
S
12710
–
L
11864
X
1.0 III
F
2
S
12720*
–
L
11865
X
1.0 III
M
2
S
12710
–
L
11866
X
1.0 III
M
44
U
–
–
–
11867
X
1.0 III
F
12
U
12690*
–
L
11868
X
1.0 III
F
20
U
12690*
–
L
11869
X
1.0 III
F
12
U
12690*
–
L
11870
X
1.0 III
M
52
U
–
–
–
11871
X
1.0 III
F
12
U
12690*
–
L
11872
X
1.0 III
F
28
U
12690*
–
L
11873
X
1.0 III
F
12
U
12690*
–
L
11874
X
2.3 II
M
3
U
–
–
–
11875
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11876
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11877
O
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11878
O
4.8
M
4
U
12370
–
Y
11879
X
4.8
F
6
U
12380
–
Y
11880
X
8.0
F
3
U
12400
–
Y
11881
X
9.5
F
1
U
–
–
–
11882
X
12480
–
Y
–
12790*
L,Y
11883
X
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
11884
X
1.0 III
F
2
U
12690*
–
L
11885
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11886
O
1.0 III
F
2
U
12690*
–
L
11851
X
11853
X
6.3
F
1
11854
X
1.0 III
M
11856
O
1.0 III
11857
X
11858
2.3 II
4.8
1.5
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
4.8
2.3 II
F
M
F
F
20
25
25
19
6
19
6
4
20
S
S
U
U
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
368
Memo
82998–
12480
F
4
Sleeve
Color
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–55
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
11889
X
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
11890
X
1.0 III
F
2
U
12690*
–
L
11891
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
12670*
–
L
11892
X
1.0 III
F
4
U
12690*
–
L
11893
X
12480
–
Y
–
12790*
L,Y
11898
X
12720*
–
L
11899
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11900
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11901
X
2.3 II
M
2
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11902
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
11903
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11904
X
12710
–
L
11905
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11906
X
SL
F
83
U
12130
–
L,Y
11907
X
SL
F
3
S
–
–
–
11908
X
SL
F
5
U
12130
–
L,Y
11909
O
1.0 III
F
5
U
12690*
–
L
11910
X
1.0 III
M
14
U
12670*
–
L
11911
O
1.0 III
F
14
U
12690*
–
L
11912
X
1.0 III
M
18
U
12670*
–
L
11913
O
1.0 III
F
18
U
12690*
–
L
11914
O
1.0 III
F
18
U
12640
–
L
11915
O
1.0 III
F
22
U
12690*
–
L
11916
X
1.0 III
M
40
U
–
–
–
11917
X
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
11918
O
1.0 III
F
2
U
12690*
–
L
11919
O
1.0 III
F
2
U
12640
–
L
11920
O
1.0 III
M
5
U
12670*
–
L
11921
O
1.0 III
F
5
U
12640
–
L
11922
X
1.0 III
M
10
U
12670*
–
L
11923
O
1.0 III
F
10
U
12690*
–
L
11924
O
1.0 III
F
10
U
12640
–
L
IDC
11925
O
1.0 III
F
14
U
12640
–
L
IDC
11926
O
1.0 III
M
22
U
12670*
–
L
4.8
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.8
1.0
1.8
1.0
1.0 III
1.0 III
1.0 III
1.3
2.3 II
F
F
M
M
M
M
M
4
20
2
8
18
6
32
5
44
5
16
4
S
S
U
U
U
S
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
IDC
PCB
IDC
IDC
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
369
E–56
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
11927
O
1.0 III
F
22
U
12640
–
L
IDC
11928
X
1.0 III
M
54
U
–
–
–
PCB
11929
X
2.3 II
M
4
S
12430*
–
L,Y
11930
X
2.3 II
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
11933
X
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
11934
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11935
X
12690*
–
L
12740
–
L
11936
X
8.0
M
3
U
12390
–
Y
11937
X
INVERTER
M
3
U
–
–
–
11938
X
INVERTER
F
3
U
–
–
–
11939
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11940
X
PIN
M
2
S
–
–
–
11941
X
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
11942
O
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
11943
X
SOCKET
F
1
S
–
–
–
11944
O
SOCKET
F
1
S
–
–
–
11945
O
PIN
M
2
S
–
–
–
11946
X
1.0 III
M
5
U
–
–
–
11947
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11948
O
1.0 III
F
10
U
12640
–
L
IDC
11949
X
1.0 III
M
18
U
–
–
–
PCB
11950
X
1.0 III
F
4
U
12690*
–
L
11951
X
1.0 III
M
13
U
–
–
–
11952
X
1.0 III
F
13
U
12690*
–
L
11953
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11954
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11955
X
1.0 III
F
19
U
12690*
–
L
11956
X
1.0 III
F
21
U
12690*
–
L
11957
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11960
X
12440*
12590
L,Y
1.0 III
1.0 IV
1.0 III
1.0 IV
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
2.3 II
M
F
F
M
F
F
F
81
24
20
11
8
4
64
14
8
9
16
5
5
U
U
U
U
U
U
S
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
370
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–57
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.0 III
Memo
82998–
–
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
1
S
–
–
–
F
4
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
8.0
M
4
U
–
–
–
PCB
X
1.0 II
M
22
U
–
–
–
PCB
11967
O
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
11968
X
1.0 III
M
5
U
–
–
–
PCB
11969
X
1.0 III
M
14
U
–
–
–
PCB
11970
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11971
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11972
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11973
O
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
11974
X
1.0 III
F
20
U
12690*
–
L
11976
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11978
X
OBD II
F
16
U
–
–
–
11985
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
–
–
–
11986
O
1.0 III
F
6
U
12690*
–
L
11987
X
1.0 III
F
3
U
12690*
–
L
11988
O
1.0 III
F
4
U
12640
–
L
11989
X
1.0 III
F
8
U
12690*
–
L
11990
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
11992
X
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
11993
X
1.0 III
M
10
U
–
–
–
PCB
11994
X
2.3 II
M
3
U
–
–
–
PCB
11995
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
11996
X
9.5
F
2
U
–
–
–
12002
X
12670*
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
12003
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12004
X
1.0
M
6
U
–
–
–
12005
X
2.3 II
F
4
S
–
12790*
L,Y
11961
X
11962
X
9.5
M
1
11963
X
9.5
F
11964
O
2.3 II
11965
X
11966
1.0 III
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
M
5
Sleeve
Color
M
F
M
F
M
M
F
28
16
4
16
4
49
14
10
8
37
18
6
5
6
5
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
IDC
PCB
IDC
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
371
E–58
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
12006
O
–
12007
X
–
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12008
O
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12009
X
–
–
–
12010
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12011
X
1.0 III
M
18
U
–
–
–
12012
X
1.0 III
F
6
U
12690*
–
L
12013
X
1.0 III
M
6
U
–
–
–
12014
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12015
X
1.0 III
M
14
U
–
–
–
12016
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
12670*
–
L
12017
X
1.0 III
F
4
U
12690*
–
L
12018
X
2.3 II
F
4
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12019
X
1.0 III
F
4
U
12640
–
L
12020
O
12480
–
Y
12720*
–
L
12021
O
12480
–
Y
12720*
–
L
12022
X
12480
–
Y
12720*
–
L
12023
X
1.0 III
M
10
U
12660
–
L
12024
X
1.0 III
M
22
U
12670*
–
L
12025
X
12670*
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
12026
X
2.3 II
F
9
U
24220
–
L
IDC
12027
X
2.3 II
F
13
U
24220
–
L
IDC
12028
O
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12029
X
1.0
M
2
U
–
–
–
12030
X
1.0 III
M
22
U
–
–
–
12031
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12032
X
–
–
–
12033
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12034
X
12380
–
Y
12690*
–
L
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.0 III
2.3 II
4.8
1.0 III
4.8
1.0 III
4.8
1.0 III
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 J
1.8 J
1.0 J
4.8
1.0 III
4.8
1.0 III
F
M
M
F
F
F
M
M
F
M
F
4
9
2
8
10
10
8
4
30
4
23
4
16
16
4
60
16
12
2
18
2
18
–
82998–
–
F
–
Memo
–
1.0 III
–
Sleeve
Color
U
U
U
U
S
S
S
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
372
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
IDC
IDC
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–59
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
1.0 III
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
U
–
–
–
1
U
–
–
–
5
U
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
U
–
–
–
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12480
–
Y
12500
–
Y
U
12670*
–
L
7
U
12690*
–
L
M
8
U
–
–
–
1.0 III
M
2
U
12670*
–
L
X
1.0 III
F
2
U
12690*
–
L
12064
X
1.0 III
M
6
U
–
–
–
12067
X
1.0 III
F
6
U
12690*
–
L
12068
X
8.0
F
2
S
12500
–
Y
12070
X
2.3 II
F
24
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12071
X
2.3 II
F
32
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12079
X
B TO J
F
24
U
–
–
–
12080
X
1.0 III
F
8
S
12720*
–
L
12081
X
1.0 III
M
29
U
12670*
–
L
12082
X
1.0 III
F
14
U
12690*
–
L
12087
X
1.0 III
M
20
U
–
–
–
12088
O
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12089
X
2.3 II
F
2
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12090
X
2.3 II
F
12
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12091
X
1.0 III
F
8
U
12690*
–
L
12092
O
–
–
–
12740
–
L
12093
X
1.0 III
M
16
U
–
–
–
12094
X
1.0 III
F
16
U
12690*
–
L
12035
X
12036
X
12037
X
12038
O
12039
X
VH
F
2
12041
X
HFC
M
12050
X
1.0 III
M
12055
X
12056
X
0.64
F
6
12057
X
2.3 II
F
4
12058
X
12059
X
1.0 III
M
7
12060
X
1.0 III
F
12061
X
1.0 III
12062
X
12063
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
1.0 IV
4.8
8.0
0.64
1.0 IV
M
M
F
M
F
F
6
5
16
4
16
4
100
22
1
2
5
2
U
U
U
U
U
S
U
Memo
82998–
–
M
41
Sleeve
Color
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
373
E–60
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
12095
X
M6 NUT
12096
X
–
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12101
X
2.3 II
F
16
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12102
X
2.3 II
F
28
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12104
X
2.3 II
F
16
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12105
X
2.3 II
M
16
U
12330*
–
L,Y
12106
X
2.3 II
F
20
U
12340*
–
L,Y
12108
X
2.3 II
M
18
U
–
–
–
12109
X
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12110
X
VALVE
F
2
U
–
–
–
12111
X
VALVE
F
2
U
–
–
–
12112
X
1.0 III
M
8
U
–
–
–
12113
X
1.0 III
F
8
U
12690*
–
L
12114
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12116
O
12480
–
Y
12720*
–
L
12117
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
–
12790*
L,Y
12118
X
8.0
M
2
U
–
–
–
PCB
12119
X
8.0
M
2
U
–
–
–
PCB
12120
X
8.0
F
2
U
12400
–
Y
12122
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12123
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
12670*
–
L
12125
X
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
12129
X
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
12131
X
BUS–
BAR
M
3
S
–
–
–
12134
X
1.0 III
M
10
U
–
–
–
12135
X
1.0 III
F
10
U
12690*
–
L
12136
X
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
12137
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12138
O
–
–
–
12140
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12141
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
4.8
1.0 III
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
PAI 1
1.0 II
1.8 II
0.64
1.0 IV
F
F
F
M
F
M
M
12
20
6
28
4
20
6
12
14
6
2
48
16
133
34
S
82998–
–
F
3
Memo
–
1.0 III
F
Sleeve
Color
U
U
S
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
374
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–61
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
0.64
Memo
82998–
12750*
–
L
12740
–
L
12750*
–
L
12740
–
L
12750*
–
L
12740
–
L
12750*
–
L
12740
–
L
12750*
–
L
12740
–
L
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12750*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12750*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12750*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
U
–
–
–
32
U
12750*
–
L
F
16
U
12750*
–
L
0.64
F
16
U
12770
–
L
IDC
X
0.64
M
16
U
–
–
–
PCB
12159
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
12670*
–
L
12160
X
1.0 III
F
4
U
12690*
–
L
12161
X
12670*
–
L
12330*
–
L,Y
12162
X
1.0 III
F
10
U
12690*
–
L
12163
X
2.3 II
M
8
S
12430*
–
L,Y
12164
X
2.3 II
F
8
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12165
O
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
12166
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12167
X
1.0 III
M
8
U
–
–
–
12168
X
1.0 III
F
3
S
12720*
–
L
12169
X
0.64
F
40
U
12750*
–
L
12170
X
0.64
F
40
U
12770
–
L
12142
X
12143
X
12144
X
12145
X
12146
X
12147
X
12148
X
12149
X
12150
X
12151
X
12152
X
0.64
M
32
12153
X
0.64
F
12155
X
0.64
12156
X
12157
1.0 IV
0.64
1.0 IV
0.64
1.0 IV
0.64
1.0 IV
0.64
1.0 IV
0.64
2.3 II
0.64
2.3 II
0.64
2.3 II
0.64
2.3 II
0.64
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
F
24
Sleeve
Color
F
F
F
F
M
M
F
F
F
M
F
7
25
7
27
7
28
7
29
6
68
12
40
10
20
4
20
6
28
2
8
9
14
6
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
IDC
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
375
E–62
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
12171
X
0.64
M
40
U
–
–
–
PCB
12174
X
1.0 II
F
18
U
24020*
–
L
IDC
12176
O
2.3 II
F
4
S
–
12790*
L,Y
12177
X
2.3 II
M
4
S
–
–
L,Y
12179
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12182
X
0.64
M
12
U
–
–
–
12183
X
0.64
F
12
U
12750*
–
L
12184
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12188
X
2.3 II
F
2
S
12440*
12590
L,Y
12189
X
1.0 III
M
5
U
12670*
–
L
12190
X
1.0 III
F
5
U
12690*
–
L
12191
X
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12192
X
0.64
M
16
U
–
–
–
12193
X
0.64
M
24
U
–
–
–
12194
X
1.0 III
M
2
S
12710
–
L
12195
X
1.0 III
F
2
S
12720*
–
L
12196
X
D–3
M
3
U
–
–
–
12197
X
D–3
F
3
U
–
–
–
12198
X
D–3
M
6
U
–
–
–
12199
X
D–3
F
6
U
–
–
–
12200
X
0.64
F
24
U
12750*
–
L
12202
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12203
X
12750*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12204
X
1.0 III
M
6
U
12670*
–
L
12205
X
2.3 II
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
12206
X
2.3 II
M
16
U
–
–
–
PCB
12207
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12208
X
1.0 III
M
6
U
–
–
–
12209
O
1.0 III
F
6
U
12690*
–
L
12210
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
–
–
–
12211
O
1.0 III
F
4
U
12690*
–
L
12212
X
1.0 III
M
4
U
12670*
–
L
12213
X
0.64
M
40
U
–
–
–
PCB
12214
X
0.64
M
24
U
–
–
–
PCB
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
0.64
2.3 II
0.64
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
F
F
M
F
M
42
4
30
12
20
6
20
6
26
8
U
U
U
U
U
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
376
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
PCB
E–63
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
Sleeve
Color
Memo
82998–
12215
X
0.64
M
24
U
–
–
–
PCB
12216
X
0.64
M
8
U
–
–
–
PCB
12217
X
0.64
F
8
U
12750*
–
L
12218
X
PAI 1
M
2
U
–
–
–
12219
X
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12220
X
0.64
M
8
U
–
–
–
12221
X
0.64
F
8
U
12750*
–
L
12222
X
0.64
F
12
U
12750*
–
L
12223
X
PAI 1
M
2
U
–
–
–
12224
X
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12225
X
0.64
F
4
U
12750*
–
L
12226
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12227
X
9.5
M
3
S
–
–
–
12228
X
9.5
F
3
S
–
–
–
12230
X
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
12231
X
LA
F
1
S
–
–
–
12232
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12233
X
–
–
–
–
–
–
12234
X
4.8
M
3
S
12470
–
Y
12237
X
4.8
F
3
S
12480
–
Y
12241
X
0.64
F
2
U
12750*
–
L
12242
X
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12243
X
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12249
X
2.3 II
M
10
U
12330*
–
L,Y
12250
X
0.64
M
11
U
–
–
–
12251
X
0.64
F
11
U
12750*
–
L
12252
X
0.64
M
16
U
–
–
–
12253
O
PAI 1
F
2
U
–
–
–
12258
X
0.64
M
20
U
–
–
–
12259
X
0.64
F
20
U
12750*
–
L
12260
X
0.64
M
24
U
–
–
–
PCB
12269
X
0.64
M
12
U
–
–
–
PCB
12270
X
0.64
M
24
U
–
–
–
PCB
12271
X
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12272
X
12690*
–
L
1.0 III
2.3 II
0.64
1.0 IV
0.64
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
F
M
M
F
F
6
4
108
27
20
6
20
6
10
U
U
U
U
U
PCB
Splash Proof
PCB
PCB
Splash Proof
PCB
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
377
E–64
HOUSING PART NUMBER LIST
Part No. of
Connector
Body
Supply
Terminal
Part No. of Repair Wire
Male
Sealing
Cav. No.
500 mm
Female
Ability 160 mm
Type
Type
90980–
82998–
12273
X
12274
X
12275
X
12276
X
12277
X
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
1.0 III
2.3 II
F
F
F
F
F
4.8
12278
X
1.0 III
6
6
18
18
8
24
24
14
10
20
U
U
U
U
U
1
F
2.3 II
6
U
18
Sleeve
Color
82998–
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12380
–
Y
12690*
–
L
12340*
–
L,Y
12291
X
1.0 III
M
39
U
–
–
–
12296
X
0.64
F
3
U
12750*
–
L
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
378
Memo
PCB
D–1
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
1P Waterproof Type
D
1
1
1
1
90980–10090
90980–10115
90980–10197
90980–10201
1
1
1
1
90980–10241
90980–10247
90980–10705
90980–10439
90980–10837
1
1
1
1
90980–10893
90980–10983
90980–11007
90980–11166
1
1
1
1
90980–11184
90980–11243
90980–11252
90980–11271
1
1
1
90980–11282
90980–11363
90980–11400
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
76
1
90980–11428
D–2
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
1P Waterproof Type
1
1
1
1
90980–11941
90980–11942
90980–11943
90980–11944
1
1
90980–12125
90980–12129
90980–12136
1
90980–11963
D
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
77
D–3
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
1
90980–10092
1 2
D
1
1
2
2
1
2
90980–10123
90980–10157
90980–10184
2
1
2
90980–10193
90980–10243
1 2
1 2
90980–10498
90980–10706
90980–10532
1
90980–10567
1
12
2
2
90980–10581
2
90980–10583
2
90980–10474
1
2
90980–10534
1
90980–10572
1
1
2
90980–10576
1 2
90980–10593
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
78
1 2
90980–10496
1 2
90980–10556
1 2
90980–10578
1
2
90980–10595
D–4
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
1 2
1
2
90980–10598
90980–10609
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
90980–10617
90980–10622
1
2
1 2
90980–10623
90980–10626
90980–10702
90980–10720
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
90980–10734
90980–10735
90980–10736
90980–10737
1 2
1 2
90980–10839
90980–10843
90980–10847
1 2
1 2
1 2
90980–10887
90980–10899
90980–10901
12
1
90980–10748
90980–10846
1
2
90980–10853
2
D
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
79
D–5
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
1
2
90980–10923
90980–10974
1
2
90980–11019
1
2
90980–11038
1
2
90980–11068
2
90980–10928
1
1 2
D
1
2
90980–11003
1
2
90980–11025
90980–11401
1
2
90980–11051
1 2
90980–11070
1 2
1 2
90980–10947
90980–10949
1 2
1 2
90980–11005
90980–11009
1 2
2
90980–11030
90980–11032
1 2
1 2
90980–11061
90980–11062
1
2
90980–11075
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
80
1
1
2
90980–11095
D–6
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
1
2
1
2
90980–11096
90980–11140
12
12
90980–11153
90980–11154
90980–11284
1
1 2
90980–11235
1
2
90980–11250
2
1
90980–11142
1
2
90980–11149
1 2
90980–11156
90980–11162
1
1 2
90980–11176
1
2
D
2
1 2
90980–11163
1
2
90980–11189
1
2
2
90980–11207
1
2
90980–11237
90980–11246
90980–11248
1 2
1 2
12
90980–11255
90980–11273
90980–11285
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
81
D–7
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
1
2
90980–11286
1
2
1 2
90980–11410
1
1
90980–11659
1
2
90980–11856
1
2
90980–11898
1
2
90980–12117
90980–11467
1 2
90980–11900
1 2
90980–12188
1 2
90980–11773
2
90980–11859
2
90980–11790
1 2
1 2
90980–11864
1
2
90980–12028
1
2
90980–12195
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
82
2
2
90980–11660
1
1
90980–11448
1
D
2
90980–11875
1
2
90980–12068
D–8
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Waterproof Type
1
2
1
3
90980–10088
2
3
90980–10239
1 2
3
3
3
90980–10110
90980–10191
90980–10199
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
2
3
90980–10245
2
3
90980–10249
2
3
90980–10341
90980–11491
D
1
2
3
1 2 3
1
2
1 2 3
3
90980–10353
1 2
3
90980–10554
1 2
90980–10395
90980–10494
90980–10501
1 2 3
1 2 3
1 2 3
90980–10574
90980–10579
90980–10629
1
2
3
3
90980–10683
90980–10690
90980–11157
1 2 3
1
2
3
90980–10695
90980–10834
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
83
D–9
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Waterproof Type
1
2
3
90980–10841
1 2 3
90980–10845
1
3
90980–10902
90980–10919
1 2 3
3
1 2 3
1 2
3
90980–10981
90980–11016
90980–11020
90980–11045
1 2 3
1 2
3
1 2 3
1 2 3
90980–11108
90980–11132
90980–11143
90980–11145
2
3
2
2
1 2 3
1 2 3
3
90980–11161
1
2
1
1
3
90980–11294
90980–11170
1
2
3
90980–11349
90980–11245
1 2
3
90980–11451
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
84
2
3
1
D
1 2
90980–11261
1
2
3
90980–11860
D–10
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Waterproof Type
1
1 2 3
1
90980–11907
1
2
2
3
90980–12058
2
3
90980–12095
1 2 3
90980–12168
3
90980–12228
D
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
85
D–11
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
1 2
3
90980–10095
3
4
4
90980–10140
90980–10220
1
1
2
2
3
4
90980–10373
1 2
3 4
90980–10476
1
3
90980–10203
1
3
2
4
90980–10549
2
1
2
4
3
4
90980–10649
90980–10663
90980–10664
1234
1 2 3 4
90980–10701
90980–10711
90980–10831
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–10869
90980–10929
90980–10591
1
3
2
2
4
90980–10218
1
3
2
4
90980–10551
1
3
2
4
90980–10685
1 2
4
1
2
3
4
90980–10940
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
86
1
3
1 2
3 4
3
4
90980–10844
1 2
3 4
90980–10942
D–12
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Waterproof Type
1
2
1
3
4
90980–10943
1
2
3
4
90980–11037
3
1
3
1
3
2
4
90980–11065
90980–11066
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
2
4
90980–11036
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–11139
90980–11150
90980–11269
1
2
3
90980–11292
1
3
90980–11028
1 2
3 4
90980–11178
2
4
90980–11288
4
90980–10990
1 2
3 4
90980–11152
2
4
90980–11304
1
3
2
4
90980–11283
1 2
3 4
90980–11329
90980–11330
3
1
2
3
4
1
2
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–11857
90980–11885
5
90980–11569
90980–11640
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
87
D–13
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Waterproof Type
1
3
2
4
90980–11930
1
2
1 2
3
4
3 4
90980–11964
90980–12005
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
88
1 2 3 4
90980–12057
D–14
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
5P Waterproof Type
1 2
4
1
3
5
2
3 4 5
90980–10162
90980–10393
12345
1 2 3
4
90980–10624
1 2 3
4
5
90980–10550
90980–10558
1
1 2 3 4 5
5
90980–10710
90980–10712
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
90980–10946
1
2
4
5
90980–11022
90980–11024
90980–11049
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
90980–11182
90980–11232
1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5
90980–11317
3
5
90980–11077
1
3
2
4
5
90980–11413
1 2 3
4 5
4 5
90980–11599
2
3 4 5
1 2 3
4
12345
90980–11904
90980–11960
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
89
D–15
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
6P Waterproof Type
1
4
2
5
3
6
90980–10097
1 2 3
4 5 6
90980–10195
1
1 2 3
4 5 6
4
2
5
1 2 3
4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
90980–10988
90980–11034
4
5
3
5
6
90980–10478
1 2 3
4 5 6
6
90980–10651
2
2
4
3
90980–10643
1
1
90980–10854
1
4
2
5
90980–11144
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
6
4
5
6
4
5
6
90980–11197
90980–11290
2
3
4
5
6
90980–10597
1
2
3
4
5
6
90980–10939
1
2
3
4
5
6
90980–11194
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–11663
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
90
3
6
1
90980–11858
D–16
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
7P, 8P Waterproof Type
1
1
2
2
1 2 3
3
4
6
7 8
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
3 4 5
6 7
4 5 6 7
90980–10628
90980–10931
90980–11172
90980–10205
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
5 6 7 8
90980–10897
90980–11190
1
4
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
1
5
2
6
3
7
6
7
90980–10891
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
90980–12080
8
90980–10895
1
4
7
4
8
90980–11242
2
5
3
2
5
8
3
6
1
90980–11461
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
2
3
4
5 6 7 8
90980–11592
1 2 3 4
5
6
7
8
90980–11593
90980–12164
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
91
D–17
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
9P Waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
90980–10380
90980–10381
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
6
2
3
7
4
8
1 2 3 4
5 678 9
90980–10678
90980–10686
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–11192
5
9
90980–11784
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
92
1
5
90980–10776
1
12 34 56 78 9
2
6
3
7
8
4
9
90980–11643
D–18
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Waterproof Type
1 2
1
7
3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10
90980–11231
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
5
2
8
6
3 4
9 10
90980–11332
8
9
10
90980–11653
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9 10
5
90980–11658
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
93
D–19
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
11P Waterproof Type
1
4
7
9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011
90980–11174
90980–11240
1
4
7
9
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 1011
90980–11257
3
6
5
8
10 11
2
90980–11612
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
94
3
5
6
8
10 11
2
D–20
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Waterproof Type
1 2
3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
90980–10548
90980–10569
1 2 3 4
1
7
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
90980–11087
1
7
2
8
3
9
4
5
2 3 4 5 6
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11151
6
1 2
3 4
10 11 12
7 8
9 10 11 12
90980–11664
5 6
90980–11698
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
95
D–21
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
13P, 15P Waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7
8 9
10 11
12 13
1 2 3
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
90980–10654
90980–11089
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
90980–11677
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
96
4 5 6
D–22
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P, 17P, 23P Waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
1 2
4 5 6
9 10 11
14 15
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
90980–10101
90980–10288
5 6 7
1
2
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
8
9
1 2 3 4
3
7 8
12 13
16
12 13
90980–11463
3
4
6
5
7
10 11
14
15
16 17
90980–11601
1 2 3
4
5 6
18
19
1 2 3
4
5 6
7 8 9
18
19
7 8 9
12 13 14
10 11 20
15
12 13 14
10 11 20
15
16 17 21 22 23
16 17 21 22 23
90980–11195
90980–11323
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
97
D–23
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P, 25P Waterproof Type
1
1 2 3
10 11 12
4 5 6 7
2 3
4 5
6 7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15
23
24
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
13 14 15
8
9
23 24
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–11851
1
2
16
17
90980–11882
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
18 19 20 21 22 23 24
16
17
10 11 12 13 14 15
18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–11893
1
2
17
18
90980–12116
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
19 20 21 22 23 24 25
90980–11861
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
98
D–24
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
34P, 40P Waterproof Type
1
3
2
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
23
24
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34
3
1
2
23
24
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34
90980–12021
90980–12022
90980–12020
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–11215
90980–11566
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
99
D–25
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
80P Waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60
71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80
90980–11214
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
100
D–26
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
1P Non–waterproof Type
1
1
1
1
90980–10165
90980–10179
90980–10183
90980–10229
1
1
1
1
90980–10254
90980–10332
90980–10250
90980–10252
1
1
90980–10343
90980–10359
1
1
1
90980–10363
1
90980–10435
90980–10619
90980–10652
1
1
1
90980–10703
90980–10782
90980–10786
1
90980–10398
1
90980–10688
1
90980–10792
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
101
D–27
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
1P Non–waterproof Type
1
90980–10871
1
90980–10911
1
1
90980–10912
1
1
90980–10913
1
90980–10914
90980–10995
90980–11147
90980–11259
1
1
1
1
90980–11315
90980–11703
90980–11738
90980–11775
1
1
90980–11853
90980–11881
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
102
1
D–28
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
1 2
90980–10012
90980–10039
1 2
1
2
90980–10109
90980–10121
1
2
90980–10069
1 2
90980–10108
1
1
2
2
90980–10124
90980–10141
1
1
1
2
1 2
90980–10185
90980–10214
90980–10256
12
12
1 2
90980–10320
90980–10333
90980–10345
12
1 2
90980–10355
90980–10357
2
2
1
90980–10298
1
2
90980–10348
2
1
90980–10362
2
90980–10385
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
103
D–29
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Non–waterproof Type
12
90980–10423
1
1 2
1 2
90980–10425
90980–10426
90980–10465
1 2
12
90980–10482
90980–10491
1
2
90980–10481
1 2
90980–10512
2
1
2
90980–10559
1
1
90980–10621
1
2
90980–10679
2
2
90980–10760
A
90980–10511
1 2
2
1
1
2
90980–10637
A
B
1 2
90980–10783
90980–10823
B
1 2
1
2
1 2
1 2
90980–10825
90980–10835
90980–10850
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
104
90980–10855
D–30
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
1
2
90980–10860
90980–10903
1
1 2
1 2
90980–10906
1
90980–10916
1
1 2
2
2
90980–10935
1
2
2
90980–11094
1 2
90980–10960
1
2
90980–11098
1 2
90980–10962
1
90980–11080
12
2
90980–11148
12
90980–11227
90980–11278
90980–11306
1
2
1 2
1 2
90980–11386
90980–11388
90980–11212
1 2
90980–11369
1
90980–11396
2
90980–11429
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
105
D–31
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
1
90980–11436
2
1 2
90980–11579
90980–11608
1 2
1 2
90980–11736
90980–11769
1
2
90980–11684
1
2
90980–11687
1
2
90980–11824
1 2
1
2
90980–11839
1 2
2
90980–11996
1 2
2
90980–11840
1 2
90980–11886
1
1
90980–11862
12
1 2
90980–11890
90980–11918
90980–11919
1 2
1 2
1 2
90980–12014
90980–12039
90980–12063
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
106
90980–11884
D–32
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Non–waterproof Type
1
1 2
90980–12088
1
1 2
90980–12089
90980–12109
1
1
2
2
90980–12110
2
1 2
1
2
90980–12111
90980–12120
1 2
1 2
90980–12138
90980–12224
90980–12243
90980–12191
1
1
90980–12219
90980–12242
2
2
2
90980–12241
90980–12253
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
107
D–33
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Non–waterproof Type
1
1 2
1 2 3
90980–10056
90980–10070
1
1
2
3
3
2 3
1 2 3
90980–10072
90980–10111
1
1
2
2 3
3
2 3
90980–10143
90980–10189
90980–10216
1
1
1
2
3
90980–10228
90980–10222
1
2 3
2
90980–10232
3
90980–10234
90980–10258
1
1 2 3
1 2 3
90980–10365
123
90980–10483
90980–10420
12
3
2
1
2
3
3
90980–10428
12
3
90980–10464
1
2
3
90980–10489
90980–10490
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
108
3
2
90980–10618
D–34
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Non–waterproof Type
1
1 2 3
90980–10638
90980–10660
2
2
1
1
3
3
90980–10704
90980–10747
90980–10784
1
1 2 3
90980–10908
1 2 3
90980–11071
1
2
3
90980–10956
1
2
90980–11079
123
3
90980–10980
90980–11053
1 2 3
3
1
1 2 3
90980–11251
90980–11296
1
2
3
90980–11314
1
2
2
2
3
3
90980–11485
1 23
90980–11336
1
2
3
90980–11490
2
90980–11387
1
1 2 3
3
2
3
90980–11667
90980–11471
1
2
3
90980–11685
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
109
D–35
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
90980–11731
1 2 3
1 2 3
90980–11764
90980–11777
1
2
3
90980–11938
1 2 3
90980–11987
1
2
90980–12197
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
110
3
1
2
3
90980–11880
D–36
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Non–waterproof Type
90980–10002
1
1
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
90980–10127
2
3
1
3
4
90980–10196
1 2 3 4
2
1
3
3 4
2
4
1
2
3
90980–10221
1 2
90980–10142
3 4
4
2
4
90980–10171
1
3
2
4
90980–10260
90980–10307
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–10378
90980–10400
90980–10467
90980–10484
12
34
1
2 3 4
1 2
3 4
1 234
90980–10504
90980–10514
90980–10515
90980–10601
1234
1 2 3 4
90980–10716
90980–10717
1234
90980–10645
1 2 3 4
90980–10692
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
111
D–37
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
1 2
3 4
4
1
2
3
4
90980–10759
90980–10795
90980–10867
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–11013
1
2
3
4
90980–11136
B
1
2
1 2 3 4
90980–10904
1
90980–11090
90980–11107
1
2
3
4
1 2 3 4
90980–11187
90980–11313
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–11494
90980–11495
A
2
3
4
90980–11118
1 2 3 4
90980–11398
1 2
3
3 4
4
90980–11427
90980–11606
1
2
3
4
90980–11662
1
2
3
4
90980–11676
1
3
2
4
90980–11742
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
112
1 2
3 4
90980–11766
D–38
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
1 2 3 4
4
1
3
2
4
1 2 3 4
90980–11771
90980–11792
90980–11799
90980–11841
1 2 3 4
1 2
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–11892
90980–11950
90980–11988
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
90980–12017
90980–12018
90980–12019
90980–12160
1 2
1 2 3 4
3 4
90980–11842
1 2
3 4
3 4
90980–12211
90980–12225
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
113
D–39
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
5P Non–waterproof Type
1
3
4
2
5
90980–10041
1
3
4
2
5
90980–10340
1
4
1 2 3 4 5
90980–10644
1 2 3 4 5
90980–10789
5
90980–10262
1 2
3 4 5
90980–10376
1
2
3 4 5
90980–10509
1
3
3
2
1
2 3
4
5
1 2
90980–10274
12
345
90980–10487
1
3
90980–10520
2
5
4
1
2
90980–10659
1
3
4
2
5
90980–10888
90980–10713
1
3
4
2
5
345
90980–10488
12345
90980–10631
2
3
5
90980–10718
2
1
5
2 3 4 5
90980–10986
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
114
12
1
4
345
4
90980–10339
2
5
4
90980–10610
3 4 5
1
3
90980–11319
D–40
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
5P Non–waterproof Type
1
3
2
4
5
90980–11603
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
90980–11772
90980–11908
90980–11909
3 1 2
1 2 3 4 5
4 5
90980–11921
90980–12190
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
115
D–41
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
6P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
5 6
1
3
4
2
6
5
90980–10004
90980–10029
1 2 3
4 5 6
1 2
3 4
5 6
90980–10313
90980–10334
1
4
2
5
3
6
1 2 3
1
4
2
5
90980–10173
1
4
2
5
1
2
3 4 5 6
90980–10414
1 2 3
4 5 6
1
2
3 4 5 6
1
2
3 4 5 6
90980–10604
90980–10605
90980–10672
3
5
1 2 3 4 5 6
1
90980–10367
1
90980–10402
2
3
6
123
456
3
90980–10382
1
4
2
5
90980–10224
3
6
90980–10335
4 5 6
1
4
3
6
2
4
5
6
90980–10447
1
4
3
6
2
5
90980–10673
2
1
3 4 5 6
3
2
4
5
6
6
90980–10766
90980–10785
90980–10797
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
116
90980–10889
D–42
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
6P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3 4
5 6
90980–10910
1
3
4
5
2
3
4
5
6
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–10933
90980–10957
90980–10964
2
1
6
3 4 5 6
90980–10976
1
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–10996
3 4
4 5 6
5 6
90980–11001
90980–11011
1
2
3 4 5 6
3
4
5
6
90980–11280
1 2 3
4 5 6
1 2 3
90980–11488
90980–11493
4 5 6
4 5 6
90980–11617
1
2
34 5 6
90980–11297
1
1 2 3
90980–11616
1 2 3
2
1
90980–11091
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2
2
3
2
4 5
6
90980–11552
1
3 4
2
5 6
90980–11697
90980–11326
1
3
2
4
5
6
90980–11583
1
4
2
5
3
6
90980–11778
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
117
D–43
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
6P Non–waterproof Type
1
1
2
3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–11780
90980–11820
1 2 3
4 5 6
90980–12012
2
4
6
1
3
5
90980–12056
3
2
4
5
90980–11879
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–11986
1
2
3
4
5
6
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–12067
1 2 3
4 5 6
90980–12209
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
118
6
90980–12199
D–44
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
7P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
4 5
6
3
7
90980–10043
12
3
45 6 7
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
4
90980–10071
1 2 3
4 5 6 7
2
5
6
3
12
45
3
7
7
90980–10264
1
6
90980–10311
2
3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
90980–10452
90980–10460
90980–10729
90980–10772
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
90980–11340
90980–11529
90980–11740
90980–11794
90980–11165
1 2
4 5
6 7 3
90980–12060
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
119
D–45
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
8P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
1
90980–10019
4 5
2 3
6
7 8
90980–10112
1 2
1
5
3 4 5
6 7 8
2
6
3
7
4
8
1
2 3
4 5
6 7 8
90980–10113
90980–10175
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
12
3
456 78
90980–10301
90980–10321
90980–10336
1
23
4 5678
1
2 3
4 5 6 7 8
90980–10419
90980–10431
6
7
2
4
8
90980–10404
1 2
6
3 4 5
7
8
1
3 4
5
2
6 7
2 3 4
90980–10209
1
3
5
7
2
4
6
8
1
2 3
4 5 6 7 8
5
6 7 8
90980–10119
1
5
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–10148
1
3
5
1
2 3 4
6 7 8
90980–10280
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
90980–10358
1
3
5
7
2
4
6
8
90980–10449
12
3
456 7 8
8
90980–10463
90980–10517
90980–10523
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
120
90980–10799
D–46
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
8P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
4
5
1
2 3
4 5 6 7 8
6 7 8
90980–10877
90980–11439
1 2
3 4 5 6
7 8
90980–11397
1
A
B
2
5
90980–10926
3
6
7
8
3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–11321
90980–11354
1 2
2
3
4 5 6
90980–11459
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4
5
6
7
4 5
7 8
90980–11130
3
90980–11533
2
3
1
1
2
3 456 78
7 8
2
6
90980–11092
1
2
1
4
1
2
3 4 5 6
7 8
1
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–11279
1
3
8
2
4 5 6 7
8
90980–11362
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
90980–11615
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–11630
90980–11633
90980–11686
90980–11701
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–11989
90980–12091
90980–12113
90980–12217
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
121
D–47
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
8P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
90980–12221
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
122
D–48
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
9P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
5 6
3 4
8 9
7
1 2
5 6
7
3 4
8 9
1 2
5 6
7
3 4
8 9
1
4
8
90980–10045
12
56
34
89
7
90980–10318
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
90980–10386
1 2
5 6
90980–11302
1 2
90980–10133
7
3 4
8 9
90980–11479
90980–10152
1 2
5 6
7
3 4
8 9
90980–10536
1 2
3
3
2
5
6
7
9
90980–10266
12
34
67 5 89
90980–11277
4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2
3
4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–11535
90980–11710
3
4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–12026
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
123
D–49
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10
90980–10158
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8
9
10
90980–10282
1
2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
90980–10304
1 2
5 6 7
3 4
8 9 10
90980–10469
7 8
2
7
3
8
4 5
9 10
90980–10177
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–10294
90980–10302
5 6 7
3 4
8 9 10
90980–10322
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9 10
90980–10377
5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–10528
90980–10669
1 2
3 4
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
124
1
6
9 10
90980–10159
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6
6
5
D–50
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
5
6
3
7
8
1 2
4
9
10
90980–10721
1
2
5
6
7
8
3
4
9
10
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–10997
1 2
5 6
3 4
7
8
1 2
1
5
2
6
3
7
8
7
A
B
9 10
8
90980–10822
4
9
3 4
5 6
90980–10801
90980–10862
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1
10
90980–10965
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
2 3 4
6
5
7 8 9 10
90980–10993
1
3
7
4
8
2
5 6
9 10
90980–11116
90980–11276
1 2
5 6 7
1 2
3 4
8 9 10
5 6
3 4
7
8
9 10
9 10
90980–11366
90980–11450
90980–11527
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
125
D–51
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4
6 7 8 9 10
6 7 8 9 10
90980–11537
90980–11581
90980–11614
1
3
5
2
A
B
1 2
4
3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–11642
90980–11657
90980–11781
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
6 7 8 9 10
90980–11817
90980–11923
5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–12008
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
126
90980–11924
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
6 7 8 9 10
90980–11948
6 7 8 9 10
90980–12135
D–52
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–12162
2
3
4
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–12226
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
9 10
90980–12272
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
127
D–53
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
11P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
6 7
8
1
2
3 4 5
6 7 8
9 10 11
3 4 5
9 1011
90980–10319
1
3
6
9
4
7
10
90980–10337
2
5
8
11
1 2 3
6 7 8
90980–10450
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9
2
5
6 7 8 9 10 11
3
4
90980–10873
4 5
10 11
9
10
11
1
2
3
6
7
8
4
9
1
2
6
3
7
8
9
5
1 2
8
9
5
10
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2
11
90980–10966
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
128
7
4
90980–10830
5
10
3
90980–10723
10 11
4
2
6
90980–10781
1
2
5
8
11
90980–10338
90980–10537
90980–10727
1
1
3 4
6 7
9 10
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 1011
90980–11041
11
D–54
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
11P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
5 6 7 8 9 1011
90980–11083
90980–11539
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 1011
90980–12003
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
129
D–55
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
3
7
90980–10006
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–10150
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10303
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–10397
1 2 3
9
7 8
4 5 6
10 11 12
90980–10421
1 2
4 5 6
8 9 10
11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10351
10 11 12
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10372
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10408
1 2 3
1 2
4 5
10 11 12
90980–10153
90980–10406
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10432
90980–10524
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
130
1 2 3
D–56
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–10565
1 2 3 4
8
90980–10632
5 6 7
9
10
11
12
1
2
7
90980–10714
1 2
6 7
5 6 7
3 4
9 10 11 12
90980–10932
4
9 10
5
6
1
11
12
7
2
7
3
8
4
9 10
4
9
10
5
6
11
12
90980–10725
1
2
3 4
7 8
90980–10803
2
3
8
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 101112
1
4 5
9 10 11 12
90980–10658
90980–10724
90980–10743
8
3
8
3 4 5
8 9 10 11 12
1 2
1 2 3
6 7 8
10 11 12
9
5 6
10 1112
90980–10879
5
6
1
11
12
7
90980–10967
2
8
3
4
9 10
5
6
11
12
90980–10968
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
131
D–57
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10973
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12
90980–11311
1 2 3
4 56 7 89
10 1112
7 8 9 10 1112
90980–11121
90980–11129
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–11408
90980–11424
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11475
90980–11531
1 2
10 1112
90980–11453
1
4 5 6 7 8 9
3 4
2
3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
101112
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11626
90980–11649
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
132
90980–11656
101112
D–58
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
7 8 9 10 11 12
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11661
90980–11693
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
90980–11720
A
1 2 3
4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
90980–11782
A
B
90980–11847
A
B
90980–11867
A
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 101112
90980–11869
90980–11871
90980–11873
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–11947
90980–12032
90980–12090
1 2 3 4 5 6
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
133
D–59
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–12183
90980–12222
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
134
1
2
7
8 9 10 11 12
3 4 5
6
90980–12273
D–60
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
13P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
7 8 9
4 5 6
10 11 12 13
90980–10033
1 2 3
7 8 9
90980–10062
90980–10132
4 5 6
10 11 12 13
1 2
1 2
3
4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3
7 8 9
90980–10324
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
10
4 5 6 7 8
11 12 13
9 10 11 12 13
90980–10480
1 2 3 4 5 6
3
4 5 6
90980–10805
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
90980–11114
1 2 3
7 8
4 5 6
9 10 11
12 13
90980–11350
90980–11115
1 2
3 4 5
90980–11199
1 2 3
7 8 9
10
4 5 6
11 12 13
6 7 8 9 10111213
90980–11394
90980–11478
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
135
D–61
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
13P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
90980–11542
90980–11604
90980–11695
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
90980–11714
90980–11827
90980–11848
1 2 3 4 5
1 2
6 7
8 9
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1011
1213
90980–11952
3 4
90980–12007
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
136
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
90980–12027
D–62
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
90980–10330
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10368
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10369
1 2 3
90980–10371
4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10471
90980–10507
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
137
D–63
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1
7
2 3
4 5
6
8 9
10 11 12 13
14
1 2 3
7 8 9
10 11
12 13 14
90980–10538
90980–10608
1 2 3
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10633
90980–10634
4 5 6
1 2
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314
90980–10807
90980–11437
3 4
5 6
7
8 9
10 11
12
13 14
90980–10813
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
138
4 5 6
D–64
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
1
2
8
9 10 11 12 13 14
4 5 6
7 8 9 10
A
B
11 12 13 14
90980–10852
3 4 5
6
90980–11225
1 2 3
1
2
5 6 7
A B
3
4
7 8 9
10 11
12 13 14
90980–11433
1
2
4 5 6
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11383
1
7
A B
3
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
4
9 1011121314
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11465
90980–11511
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
139
D–65
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11556
1 2 3
2 3
4 5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11591
4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11791
90980–11805
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
8 9 1011121314
90980–11911
90980–11925
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
140
1
D–66
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
90980–12082
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
141
D–67
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
15P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
8 9 10 11
90980–10066
1
3
5 6
7
8 9
10
11 12
13 14 15
12
13 14 15
90980–10331
2
4
1 2
3
7 8
9 10
90980–10443
1
3 4
5 6
12 13
14 15
90980–10563
1 2
2
5
11
4
3
6 7
4 5 6 7 8 9
8 9 10 11 12
10 11 12 13 14 15
13
14
15
90980–10815
90980–10828
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
142
5 6 7
D–68
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
15P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
7
8 9 1011121314 15
4 5
6
1 2 3
90980–11042
1 2 3
90980–11056
1 2 3 4
4 5 6
8 9
7 8 9 101112131415
90980–11179
1 2 3 4
8 9
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314 15
10 11 12 13
5 6 7
14 15
90980–11264
5 6 7
10 11 12 13 14
15
90980–11372
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
143
D–69
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3
9 10 11
90980–10008
1 2 3
7 8
13
10
16
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12
11 12 13 14
15 16
14
90980–10454
1
5
2
6
7
5 6 7 8
13 14 15 16
90980–10028
4 5 6
9
15
4
12
90980–10486
3
4
8
9
1 2 3
4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10522
90980–10525
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
144
D–70
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
5 6
7
8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15
16
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10539
1 2
90980–10543
3 4
1234
5 6 7 8 9 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10561
1 2 3 4
567 8
90980–10611
5 6 7
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10613
90980–10614
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
145
D–71
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10635
90980–10636
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10740
90980–10764
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10809
90980–11445
3 4
5 6
7
8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15
16
90980–10848
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
146
1 2
D–72
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
5 6
3 4
7
11 12 13
8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
14 15 16
90980–10885
90980–11082
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
5 6
7
8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16
90980–11113
90980–11219
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
90980–11391
90980–11416
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
147
D–73
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3
4
5
6 7
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
8 9 10
11 12 13 14
15 16
90980–11425
1 2 3 4
9 10 11 12
90980–11435
5 6 7 8
13 14 15 16
90980–11547
1
2 3
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–11562
1
2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
11 12 13
90980–11565
14 15 16
90980–11574
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
148
4
5
6
D–74
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–11648
90980–11652
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1 2
3 4
9 10
1112
A
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
90980–11665
90980–11978
3 4
A
9 10
1112
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2
4 5
5 6
7 8
1314
1516
B
90980–11681
5 6
7 8
1314
1516
B
90980–11683
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
90980–11787
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
149
D–75
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–12093
90980–12094
1 2 3 4 5 6
9 10 11 12 13 14
7 8
15 16
90980–12101
7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14
15 16
90980–12104
8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16 15
14 13 12 11 10 9
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–12105
90980–12155
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
150
1 2 3 4 5 6
D–76
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–12156
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
151
D–77
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
17P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
90980–10031
17 16
5 6 7 8
14 15 16 17
90980–10037
15 14
1 2 3 4
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
5 6 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
8 9 1011121314151617
90980–10731
90980–11417
90980–11420
90980–11203
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
5 6 7
4 5 6 7
8 9 10111213141516 17
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
90980–11310
90980–11335
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
152
13
D–78
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
17P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
1 2
3
4
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
11 12 13 14 15 16 17
13 14 15
90980–11506
16 17
90980–11560
1 2 3 4 5 6
1
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15
2
3
4 5 6 7
6
7
8
9 10 1112131415 16 17
16 17
90980–11586
1
2 3 4 5
90980–11671
1
2
6
7
3
4
5
8
9
8
9 10 1112131415 16 17
1011121314151617
90980–11672
90980–11954
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
153
D–79
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
18P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
9 10
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
9
14
10 11 12 13
15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–10285
90980–10295
3 4
11 12
13 14
5 6
7 8
15 16
17 18
90980–10326
1 2 3
4
5 6 7
8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–10350
12 13
14 15
11
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
16 17
18
90980–10530
90980–10656
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
154
D–80
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
18P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4
5 6 7
8 9 10
12 13
14 15
11
16 17
1 2
3 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18
18
90980–10778
1
2 3 4 5 6 7
8
90980–10819
9
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–11224
90980–11226
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
8 9 101112131415161718
10 11 12 131415 16 17 18
90980–11497
90980–11594
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
155
D–81
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
18P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 1213141516 17 18
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–11595
90980–11913
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
101112131415161718
90980–11914
1 2 3
4 5 6
90980–11973
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
7 8 9
1011121314151617 18
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–12122
90980–12174
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
156
D–82
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
19P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14
15 16
17
1 2
3 4
5 6
8 9
7
10 11
12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
18 19
90980–10675
1
3 4
7 8 9
90980–10857
2
5 6
1 2 3 4
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
90980–10883
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 101112131415161718 19
90980–11205
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
5 6 7 8
9 101112131415161718 19
9 10 11 12131415 16 1718 19
90980–11308
90980–11377
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
157
D–83
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
19P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
8 9 10
13 14 15 16
13141516171819
17 18 19
90980–11571
90980–11955
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
158
1112
D–84
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
1 2 3 4
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
10 11 12 13 14
90980–10327
1 2 3 4 5
10 11 12
90980–10589
6 7 8 9
13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20
1 2 3 4 5
5 6 7
11 12
6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–10607
1 2
5 6 7 8 9
15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–10612
3 4
1 2
8 9 10
5 6 7
13 14
11 12
15 16 17 18 19 20
3 4
8 9 10
13 14
15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–10811
90980–11441
90980–10640
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
159
D–85
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
10
11 12 13
14 15 16
17
18 19 20
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
90980–10817
A
2
1
4
3
7 10
6 9
5 8
10 7
9 6
8 5
90980–10821
4
3
B
2
1
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
90980–10952
1 2 3 4 5
10 11 12
90980–11260
6 7 8 9
13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20
1 2 3 4
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–11432
90980–11469
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
160
5 6 7 8
D–86
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–11499
90980–11558
A B
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 1213141516171819 20
5 6 7 8 9 101112
13 1415 16 171819 20
90980–11868
90980–11971
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–11974
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
2 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–12034
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
161
D–87
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–12038
1
7 8 9 10
17 18 19 20
90980–12106
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–12166
90980–12259
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
162
1 2 3 4 5 6
11 12 13 14 15 16
D–88
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
21P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
11 12 13 14 15
6 7 8 9 10
17 18 19 20 21
16
90980–10064
1
6
2
7
13 14 15
3
8
9
10
16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
90980–10207
4
5
11
12
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
101112131415161718192021
19 20 21
90980–10473
90980–11125
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
9 10
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
111213
141516171819 2021
90980–11379
90980–11956
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
163
D–89
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
21P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
6 7 8 9
3
4
5
101112
13141516171819 2021
90980–11957
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
164
D–90
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
22P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 1516 17 18 19 20 21 22
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10
11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
90980–10010
90980–10328
1 2
1 2 3 4 5
11 12 13 14 15 16
6 7 8 9 10
17 18 19 20 21 22
5 6
3 4
7
10 11 12
15 16 17
8 9
13 14
18 19
20 21 22
90980–10456
1 2 3 4 5
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10458
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
17 18 19 20 21 22
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–10526
90980–10741
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
165
D–91
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
22P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
90980–10765
90980–10875
B
2
1
A
5 8 11
4 7 10
3 6 9
11 8 5
10 7 4
9 6 3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
18 19
90980–10953
20 21 22
90980–11220
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–11238
90980–11392
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
166
9 10 11
121314151617
D–92
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
22P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
10111213141516171819202122
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–11502
90980–11628
1 2 3 4 5
6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
12 13 1415161718192021 22
16 17
18 19 20 21 22
90980–11638
90980–11788
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
1213141516171819 202122
90980–11915
90980–11927
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
167
D–93
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
23P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 1718 19 20 21 22 23
1 2 3
90980–10921
4
5 6
5 6
18
19
7 8 9
12 13 14
1 2 3
4
10 11 20
15
16 17 21 22 23
90980–11195
18
19
7 8 9
12 13 14
10 11 20
15
16 17 21 22 23
1 2 3 4 5
1112 13 14 15161718 19 20 21 22 23
90980–11323
90980–11381
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
168
6 7 8 9 10
D–94
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–10296
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–10585
1 2
3 4
5 6 7
11 12 13
19 20
8 9 10
14
15
21
22
16 17 18
23 24
90980–10881
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2 1
A
7 12
6
11
5
4 10
3 9
1 2 8
B
90980–10955
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
169
D–95
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24
90980–11476
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10111213 14 15 16 17
1819
2021 22
23 24
90980–11509
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
21 22 23 24
90980–12070
1
2
3
4
5 6 7 8
9
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–12079
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
170
D–96
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
5
6
3 4
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24
90980–12149
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–12200
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
171
D–97
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
25P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 1011
1213141516171819 202122232425
90980–11043
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 1011
1213141516171819 202122232425
90980–11055
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
90980–11058
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8
9 1011
121314
151617
1819 20 21 22 232425
90980–11375
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
172
D–98
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
25P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
90980–11404
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112 13
14 15 16171819
2021222324 25
90980–11877
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24
25
90980–12278
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
173
D–99
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
7 8 9 10 11 12
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10587
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10739
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10763
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10918
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
174
D–100
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10925
1
2 3 4
14 15 16 17
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
90980–11234
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–11390
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22
9 10 11 12 13
23 24 25 26
90980–11406
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
175
D–101
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–11422
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–11423
1 2
3 4
5 6 7
8
9
13 14 15 16
10 11 12
17 18 19 20
21 22 23
24 25 26
90980–11611
1
5
13
2
3
6 7 8
9 10 11
14 15 16 17 18 19 20
22
23 24 25
26
4
12
21
90980–11632
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
176
D–102
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 1617181920212223 24 25 26
90980–11786
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
90980–12150
1
2
3
10
11
12
4 5 6 7 8 9
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–12203
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
177
D–103
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
27P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
13
15
16
17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27
14
90980–11670
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
178
D–104
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
28P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10
11
12 13
141516171819 2021
22 23 24
25 26 27 28
90980–11218
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
23 24 25 26 27 28
90980–11637
A B
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314151617
1819 2021 22 23 2425 26 27 28
90980–11872
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24
25 26 27 28
90980–12102
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
179
D–105
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
30P Non–waterproof Type
1
10
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30
90980–12151
1
2
3
4
5 6 7
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
90980–12277
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
180
D–106
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
31P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
27 28
29 30 31
90980–11421
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
27 28
29 30 31
90980–11935
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
30 31
28 29
90980–12142
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
181
D–107
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
32P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30 31 32
90980–12071
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12 13141516
17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
272829303132
90980–12096
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29
30
31 32
90980–12143
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
90980–12153
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
182
D–108
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
32P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
17 18 19 20 21 22
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
90980–12275
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
183
D–109
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
34P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12
13 14
15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
272829 30
31323334
90980–11221
1
2
3
4
5
6
18 19 20 21 22 23
7
8
9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17
24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31 32 33 34
90980–12114
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31 32
33 34
90980–12144
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
184
D–110
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
35P, 36P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
28 29 30 31
32 33
34 35
90980–12145
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35
90980–12146
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
90980–12274
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
185
D–111
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
38P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3
7 8
9
10 11 12 13
14 15 16
17 18 19
20 21 22 23
24 25 26
4
5 6
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
90980–11555
1
2 3 4 5 6
7
20 21 22 23 24 25
8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
26 27 28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
90980–12276
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
186
D–112
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
40P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011121314
15 1617 181920 21 22232425262728
29 3031 32
33 34 3536
37383940
90980–11508
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–11618
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–12169
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
187
D–113
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
40P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–12170
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
188
D–114
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
42P, 43P, 46P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31 32 33
34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
90980–12184
A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10
1112
1314
1516
1718
1920
2021
1617
9 10
1 2 3
2223
1819
1112131415
4 5 6 7 8
B
90980–11360
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
32 33 34 35 36 37
38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
90980–12179
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
189
D–115
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
49P, 55P, 83P Non–waterproof Type
A
9 10
13 14
17 18
21
1
2
5
6
26
24
2021
1415 16
7 8 9
1
10
2 3
3 4
7 8
1112
1516
19 20
22
27
25
2223
17 1819
11 1213
4 5 6
B
90980–11431
D
F
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 1011 12
2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
6
11 12 13 14
1
131415
9 1011 12
5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4
11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
6
C
E
90980–11359
90980–11906
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
190
D–116
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
88P Non–waterproof Type
B
F
E
1
3 2
6 5 4
9 8 7
9 8 7
6 5 4
3 2
1
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5
1
2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
7 8 9
4 5 6
2 3
1
D
C
A
90980–10950
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
191
D–117
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10
90980–10158
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8
9
10
90980–10282
1
2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
90980–10304
1 2
5 6 7
3 4
8 9 10
90980–10469
7 8
2
7
3
8
4 5
9 10
90980–10177
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–10294
90980–10302
5 6 7
3 4
8 9 10
90980–10322
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9 10
90980–10377
5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–10528
90980–10669
1 2
3 4
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
192
1
6
9 10
90980–10159
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6
6
5
D–118
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
5
6
3
7
8
1 2
4
9
10
90980–10721
1
2
5
6
7
8
3
4
9
10
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–10997
1 2
5 6
3 4
7
8
1 2
1
5
2
6
3
7
8
7
A
B
9 10
8
90980–10822
4
9
3 4
5 6
90980–10801
90980–10862
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1
10
90980–10965
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
2 3 4
6
5
7 8 9 10
90980–10993
1
3
7
4
8
2
5 6
9 10
90980–11116
90980–11276
1 2
5 6 7
1 2
3 4
8 9 10
5 6
3 4
7
8
9 10
9 10
90980–11366
90980–11450
90980–11527
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
193
D–119
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4
6 7 8 9 10
6 7 8 9 10
90980–11537
90980–11581
90980–11614
1
3
5
2
A
B
1 2
4
3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–11642
90980–11657
90980–11781
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
6 7 8 9 10
90980–11817
90980–11923
5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–12008
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
194
90980–11924
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
6 7 8 9 10
90980–11948
6 7 8 9 10
90980–12135
D–120
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
10P Non–waterproof Type
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–12162
2
3
4
5 6 7 8 9 10
90980–12226
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
9 10
90980–12272
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
195
D–121
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
11P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
6 7
8
1
2
3 4 5
6 7 8
9 10 11
3 4 5
9 1011
90980–10319
1
3
6
9
4
7
10
90980–10337
2
5
8
11
1 2 3
6 7 8
90980–10450
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9
2
5
6 7 8 9 10 11
3
4
90980–10873
4 5
10 11
9
10
11
1
2
3
6
7
8
4
9
1
2
6
3
7
8
9
5
1 2
8
9
5
10
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2
11
90980–10966
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
196
7
4
90980–10830
5
10
3
90980–10723
10 11
4
2
6
90980–10781
1
2
5
8
11
90980–10338
90980–10537
90980–10727
1
1
3 4
6 7
9 10
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 1011
90980–11041
11
D–122
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
11P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
5 6 7 8 9 1011
90980–11083
90980–11539
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 1011
90980–12003
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
197
D–123
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
3
7
90980–10006
1 2 3 4 5 6
90980–10150
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10303
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–10397
1 2 3
9
7 8
4 5 6
10 11 12
90980–10421
1 2
4 5 6
8 9 10
11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10351
10 11 12
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10372
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10408
1 2 3
1 2
4 5
10 11 12
90980–10153
90980–10406
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10432
90980–10524
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
198
1 2 3
D–124
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
90980–10565
1 2 3 4
8
90980–10632
5 6 7
9
10
11
12
1
2
7
90980–10714
1 2
6 7
5 6 7
3 4
9 10 11 12
90980–10932
4
9 10
5
6
1
11
12
7
2
7
3
8
4
9 10
4
9
10
5
6
11
12
90980–10725
1
2
3 4
7 8
90980–10803
2
3
8
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 101112
1
4 5
9 10 11 12
90980–10658
90980–10724
90980–10743
8
3
8
3 4 5
8 9 10 11 12
1 2
1 2 3
6 7 8
10 11 12
9
5 6
10 1112
90980–10879
5
6
1
11
12
7
90980–10967
2
8
3
4
9 10
5
6
11
12
90980–10968
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
199
D–125
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–10973
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12
90980–11311
1 2 3
4 56 7 89
10 1112
7 8 9 10 1112
90980–11121
90980–11129
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–11408
90980–11424
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11475
90980–11531
1 2
10 1112
90980–11453
1
4 5 6 7 8 9
3 4
2
3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
101112
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11626
90980–11649
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
200
90980–11656
101112
D–126
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
7 8 9 10 11 12
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12
90980–11661
90980–11693
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
90980–11720
A
1 2 3
4 5
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
90980–11782
A
B
90980–11847
A
B
90980–11867
A
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 101112
90980–11869
90980–11871
90980–11873
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
7 8 9 101112
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–11947
90980–12032
90980–12090
1 2 3 4 5 6
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
201
D–127
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
12P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
90980–12183
90980–12222
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
202
1
2
7
8 9 10 11 12
3 4 5
6
90980–12273
D–128
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
13P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
7 8 9
4 5 6
10 11 12 13
90980–10033
1 2 3
7 8 9
90980–10062
90980–10132
4 5 6
10 11 12 13
1 2
1 2
3
4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3
7 8 9
90980–10324
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
10
4 5 6 7 8
11 12 13
9 10 11 12 13
90980–10480
1 2 3 4 5 6
3
4 5 6
90980–10805
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
90980–11114
1 2 3
7 8
4 5 6
9 10 11
12 13
90980–11350
90980–11115
1 2
3 4 5
90980–11199
1 2 3
7 8 9
10
4 5 6
11 12 13
6 7 8 9 10111213
90980–11394
90980–11478
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
203
D–129
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
13P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
90980–11542
90980–11604
90980–11695
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
90980–11714
90980–11827
90980–11848
1 2 3 4 5
1 2
6 7
8 9
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1011
1213
90980–11952
3 4
90980–12007
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
204
1 2
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
90980–12027
D–130
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
90980–10330
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10368
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10369
1 2 3
90980–10371
4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10471
90980–10507
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
205
D–131
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1
7
2 3
4 5
6
8 9
10 11 12 13
14
1 2 3
7 8 9
10 11
12 13 14
90980–10538
90980–10608
1 2 3
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–10633
90980–10634
4 5 6
1 2
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314
90980–10807
90980–11437
3 4
5 6
7
8 9
10 11
12
13 14
90980–10813
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
206
4 5 6
D–132
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
1
2
8
9 10 11 12 13 14
4 5 6
7 8 9 10
A
B
11 12 13 14
90980–10852
3 4 5
6
90980–11225
1 2 3
1
2
5 6 7
A B
3
4
7 8 9
10 11
12 13 14
90980–11433
1
2
4 5 6
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11383
1
7
A B
3
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
4
9 1011121314
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11465
90980–11511
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
207
D–133
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11556
1 2 3
2 3
4 5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11591
4 5 6
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
90980–11791
90980–11805
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
8 9 1011121314
90980–11911
90980–11925
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
208
1
D–134
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
14P Non–waterproof Type
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
90980–12082
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
209
D–135
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
15P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
8 9 10 11
90980–10066
1
3
5 6
7
8 9
10
11 12
13 14 15
12
13 14 15
90980–10331
2
4
1 2
3
7 8
9 10
90980–10443
1
3 4
5 6
12 13
14 15
90980–10563
1 2
2
5
11
4
3
6 7
4 5 6 7 8 9
8 9 10 11 12
10 11 12 13 14 15
13
14
15
90980–10815
90980–10828
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
210
5 6 7
D–136
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
15P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
7
8 9 1011121314 15
4 5
6
1 2 3
90980–11042
1 2 3
90980–11056
1 2 3 4
4 5 6
8 9
7 8 9 101112131415
90980–11179
1 2 3 4
8 9
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314 15
10 11 12 13
5 6 7
14 15
90980–11264
5 6 7
10 11 12 13 14
15
90980–11372
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
211
D–137
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3
9 10 11
90980–10008
1 2 3
7 8
13
10
16
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12
11 12 13 14
15 16
14
90980–10454
1
5
2
6
7
5 6 7 8
13 14 15 16
90980–10028
4 5 6
9
15
4
12
90980–10486
3
4
8
9
1 2 3
4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10522
90980–10525
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
212
D–138
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
5 6
7
8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15
16
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10539
1 2
90980–10543
3 4
1234
5 6 7 8 9 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10561
1 2 3 4
567 8
90980–10611
5 6 7
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10613
90980–10614
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
213
D–139
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10635
90980–10636
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10740
90980–10764
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10809
90980–11445
3 4
5 6
7
8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15
16
90980–10848
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
214
1 2
D–140
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
5 6
3 4
7
11 12 13
8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
14 15 16
90980–10885
90980–11082
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
5 6
7
8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16
90980–11113
90980–11219
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
90980–11391
90980–11416
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
215
D–141
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3
4
5
6 7
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
8 9 10
11 12 13 14
15 16
90980–11425
1 2 3 4
9 10 11 12
90980–11435
5 6 7 8
13 14 15 16
90980–11547
1
2 3
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–11562
1
2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
11 12 13
90980–11565
14 15 16
90980–11574
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
216
4
5
6
D–142
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
90980–11648
90980–11652
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1 2
3 4
9 10
1112
A
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
90980–11665
90980–11978
3 4
A
9 10
1112
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2
4 5
5 6
7 8
1314
1516
B
90980–11681
5 6
7 8
1314
1516
B
90980–11683
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
90980–11787
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
217
D–143
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–12093
90980–12094
1 2 3 4 5 6
9 10 11 12 13 14
7 8
15 16
90980–12101
7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14
15 16
90980–12104
8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16 15
14 13 12 11 10 9
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–12105
90980–12155
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
218
1 2 3 4 5 6
D–144
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
16P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–12156
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
219
D–145
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
17P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4
9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
90980–10031
17 16
5 6 7 8
14 15 16 17
90980–10037
15 14
1 2 3 4
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
5 6 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
8 9 1011121314151617
90980–10731
90980–11417
90980–11420
90980–11203
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
5 6 7
4 5 6 7
8 9 10111213141516 17
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
90980–11310
90980–11335
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
220
13
D–146
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
17P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3
1 2
3
4
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
11 12 13 14 15 16 17
13 14 15
90980–11506
16 17
90980–11560
1 2 3 4 5 6
1
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15
2
3
4 5 6 7
6
7
8
9 10 1112131415 16 17
16 17
90980–11586
1
2 3 4 5
90980–11671
1
2
6
7
3
4
5
8
9
8
9 10 1112131415 16 17
1011121314151617
90980–11672
90980–11954
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
221
D–147
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
18P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
9 10
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
9
14
10 11 12 13
15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–10285
90980–10295
3 4
11 12
13 14
5 6
7 8
15 16
17 18
90980–10326
1 2 3
4
5 6 7
8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–10350
12 13
14 15
11
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
16 17
18
90980–10530
90980–10656
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
222
D–148
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
18P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4
5 6 7
8 9 10
12 13
14 15
11
16 17
1 2
3 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18
18
90980–10778
1
2 3 4 5 6 7
8
90980–10819
9
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–11224
90980–11226
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
8 9 101112131415161718
10 11 12 131415 16 17 18
90980–11497
90980–11594
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
223
D–149
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
18P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 1213141516 17 18
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–11595
90980–11913
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
101112131415161718
90980–11914
1 2 3
4 5 6
90980–11973
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
7 8 9
1011121314151617 18
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
90980–12122
90980–12174
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
224
D–150
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
19P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14
15 16
17
1 2
3 4
5 6
8 9
7
10 11
12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
18 19
90980–10675
1
3 4
7 8 9
90980–10857
2
5 6
1 2 3 4
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
90980–10883
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 101112131415161718 19
90980–11205
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
5 6 7 8
9 101112131415161718 19
9 10 11 12131415 16 1718 19
90980–11308
90980–11377
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
225
D–151
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
19P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
8 9 10
13 14 15 16
13141516171819
17 18 19
90980–11571
90980–11955
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
226
1112
D–152
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
1 2 3 4
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
10 11 12 13 14
90980–10327
1 2 3 4 5
10 11 12
90980–10589
6 7 8 9
13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20
1 2 3 4 5
5 6 7
11 12
6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–10607
1 2
5 6 7 8 9
15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–10612
3 4
1 2
8 9 10
5 6 7
13 14
11 12
15 16 17 18 19 20
3 4
8 9 10
13 14
15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–10811
90980–11441
90980–10640
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
227
D–153
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
10
11 12 13
14 15 16
17
18 19 20
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
90980–10817
A
2
1
4
3
7 10
6 9
5 8
10 7
9 6
8 5
90980–10821
4
3
B
2
1
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
90980–10952
1 2 3 4 5
10 11 12
90980–11260
6 7 8 9
13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20
1 2 3 4
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–11432
90980–11469
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
228
5 6 7 8
D–154
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–11499
90980–11558
A B
1 2
3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 1213141516171819 20
5 6 7 8 9 101112
13 1415 16 171819 20
90980–11868
90980–11971
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–11974
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
2 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–12034
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
229
D–155
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
20P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–12038
1
7 8 9 10
17 18 19 20
90980–12106
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
90980–12166
90980–12259
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
230
1 2 3 4 5 6
11 12 13 14 15 16
D–156
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
21P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
11 12 13 14 15
6 7 8 9 10
17 18 19 20 21
16
90980–10064
1
6
2
7
13 14 15
3
8
9
10
16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
90980–10207
4
5
11
12
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
101112131415161718192021
19 20 21
90980–10473
90980–11125
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
9 10
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
111213
141516171819 2021
90980–11379
90980–11956
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
231
D–157
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
21P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
6 7 8 9
3
4
5
101112
13141516171819 2021
90980–11957
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
232
D–158
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
22P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 1516 17 18 19 20 21 22
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10
11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
90980–10010
90980–10328
1 2
1 2 3 4 5
11 12 13 14 15 16
6 7 8 9 10
17 18 19 20 21 22
5 6
3 4
7
10 11 12
15 16 17
8 9
13 14
18 19
20 21 22
90980–10456
1 2 3 4 5
11 12 13 14 15 16
90980–10458
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
17 18 19 20 21 22
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–10526
90980–10741
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
233
D–159
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
22P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
90980–10765
90980–10875
B
2
1
A
5 8 11
4 7 10
3 6 9
11 8 5
10 7 4
9 6 3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
18 19
90980–10953
20 21 22
90980–11220
1 2 3
4 5
6 7
8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–11238
90980–11392
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
234
9 10 11
121314151617
D–160
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
22P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
10111213141516171819202122
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
90980–11502
90980–11628
1 2 3 4 5
6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
12 13 1415161718192021 22
16 17
18 19 20 21 22
90980–11638
90980–11788
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
1213141516171819 202122
90980–11915
90980–11927
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
235
D–161
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
23P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 1718 19 20 21 22 23
1 2 3
90980–10921
4
5 6
5 6
18
19
7 8 9
12 13 14
1 2 3
4
10 11 20
15
16 17 21 22 23
90980–11195
18
19
7 8 9
12 13 14
10 11 20
15
16 17 21 22 23
1 2 3 4 5
1112 13 14 15161718 19 20 21 22 23
90980–11323
90980–11381
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
236
6 7 8 9 10
D–162
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–10296
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–10585
1 2
3 4
5 6 7
11 12 13
19 20
8 9 10
14
15
21
22
16 17 18
23 24
90980–10881
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2 1
A
7 12
6
11
5
4 10
3 9
1 2 8
B
90980–10955
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
237
D–163
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24
90980–11476
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 10111213 14 15 16 17
1819
2021 22
23 24
90980–11509
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20
21 22 23 24
90980–12070
1
2
3
4
5 6 7 8
9
10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–12079
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
238
D–164
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
24P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
5
6
3 4
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24
90980–12149
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
90980–12200
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
239
D–165
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
25P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 1011
1213141516171819 202122232425
90980–11043
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 1011
1213141516171819 202122232425
90980–11055
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
90980–11058
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8
9 1011
121314
151617
1819 20 21 22 232425
90980–11375
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
240
D–166
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
25P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
90980–11404
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112 13
14 15 16171819
2021222324 25
90980–11877
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24
25
90980–12278
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
241
D–167
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
7 8 9 10 11 12
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10587
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10739
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10763
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10918
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
242
D–168
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–10925
1
2 3 4
14 15 16 17
5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
90980–11234
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–11390
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22
9 10 11 12 13
23 24 25 26
90980–11406
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
243
D–169
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–11422
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–11423
1 2
3 4
5 6 7
8
9
13 14 15 16
10 11 12
17 18 19 20
21 22 23
24 25 26
90980–11611
1
5
13
2
3
6 7 8
9 10 11
14 15 16 17 18 19 20
22
23 24 25
26
4
12
21
90980–11632
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
244
D–170
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
26P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 1617181920212223 24 25 26
90980–11786
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
90980–12150
1
2
3
10
11
12
4 5 6 7 8 9
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
90980–12203
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
245
D–171
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
27P Non–waterproof Type
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
13
15
16
17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27
14
90980–11670
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
246
D–172
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
28P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10
11
12 13
141516171819 2021
22 23 24
25 26 27 28
90980–11218
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22
23 24 25 26 27 28
90980–11637
A B
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314151617
1819 2021 22 23 2425 26 27 28
90980–11872
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24
25 26 27 28
90980–12102
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
247
D–173
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
30P Non–waterproof Type
1
10
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30
90980–12151
1
2
3
4
5 6 7
16 17 18 19 20 21 22
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
90980–12277
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
248
D–174
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
31P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
27 28
29 30 31
90980–11421
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
27 28
29 30 31
90980–11935
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
30 31
28 29
90980–12142
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
249
D–175
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
32P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30 31 32
90980–12071
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10
11 12 13141516
17 18 19 20 21 22
23 24 25 26
272829303132
90980–12096
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29
30
31 32
90980–12143
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
90980–12153
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
250
D–176
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
32P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
17 18 19 20 21 22
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
90980–12275
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
251
D–177
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
34P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12
13 14
15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
272829 30
31323334
90980–11221
1
2
3
4
5
6
18 19 20 21 22 23
7
8
9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17
24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31 32 33 34
90980–12114
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31 32
33 34
90980–12144
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
252
D–178
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
35P, 36P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
28 29 30 31
32 33
34 35
90980–12145
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35
90980–12146
1
2
3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
90980–12274
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
253
D–179
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
38P Non–waterproof Type
1 2
3
7 8
9
10 11 12 13
14 15 16
17 18 19
20 21 22 23
24 25 26
4
5 6
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
90980–11555
1
2 3 4 5 6
7
20 21 22 23 24 25
8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
26 27 28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
90980–12276
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
254
D–180
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
40P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011121314
15 1617 181920 21 22232425262728
29 3031 32
33 34 3536
37383940
90980–11508
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–11618
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–12169
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
255
D–181
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
40P Non–waterproof Type
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
90980–12170
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
256
D–182
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
42P, 43P, 46P Non–waterproof Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27
28 29 30 31 32 33
34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
90980–12184
A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10
1112
1314
1516
1718
1920
2021
1617
9 10
1 2 3
2223
1819
1112131415
4 5 6 7 8
B
90980–11360
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
32 33 34 35 36 37
38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
90980–12179
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
257
D–183
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
49P, 55P, 83P Non–waterproof Type
A
9 10
13 14
17 18
21
1
2
5
6
26
24
2021
1415 16
7 8 9
1
10
2 3
3 4
7 8
1112
1516
19 20
22
27
25
2223
17 1819
11 1213
4 5 6
B
90980–11431
D
F
1 2 3 4
5 6 7 8
9 1011 12
2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
6
11 12 13 14
1
131415
9 1011 12
5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4
11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
6
C
E
90980–11359
90980–11906
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
258
D–184
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
88P Non–waterproof Type
B
F
E
1
3 2
6 5 4
9 8 7
9 8 7
6 5 4
3 2
1
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
20 21 22 23 24 25 26
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5
1
2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
7 8 9
4 5 6
2 3
1
D
C
A
90980–10950
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
259
D–185
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
1P Waterproof Type
1
1
1
1
90980–10114
90980–10125
90980–10200
90980–10240
1
1
1
90980–10246
90980–10438
90980–10836
90980–10892
1
1
1
1
90980–10982
90980–11006
90980–11183
90980–11270
1
90980–11962
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
260
1
D–186
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
2
90980–10091
2
1
1
2
2
90980–10122
90980–10156
90980–10412
90980–10192
2 1
2 1
1
1
2
1
2 1
90980–10242
90980–10374
90980–10495
90980–10497
2 1
2 1
2 1
2 1
90980–10533
90980–10555
90980–10707
90980–10566
90980–10571
2
1
90980–10575
2
1
90980–10594
2
1
90980–10580
2 1
90980–10625
90980–10788
2
90980–10582
2
2 1
1
1
90980–10665
90980–10592
2
1
90980–10838
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
261
D–187
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
2 1
2 1
2 1
2 1
90980–10842
90980–10886
90980–10898
90980–10900
2 1
2 1
90980–10948
90980–10959
90980–10970
2 1
2 1
2 1
90980–11004
90980–11008
90980–11029
1
2
1
90980–10927
2
1
90980–11002
2
1
90980–11031
2
1
90980–11050
2
2
2 1
90980–11069
2
90980–11137
1
90980–11141
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
262
2
1
90980–11072
1
1
90980–11073
90980–11074
2
2 1
90980–11155
D–188
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
2 1
90980–11168
2
1
90980–11247
2
90980–11175
2
1
1
90980–11303
2
1
90980–11249
2
2
2
2 1
1
90980–11322
1
90980–11188
90980–11236
2 1
2 1
90980–11254
90980–11272
2 1
2
1
90980–11409
90980–11447
2 1
2 1
90980–11789
90980–11854
1
2
90980–11466
2 1
90980–11863
1
90980–11486
1
2
1
90980–11865
2
1
1
90980–11901
90980–11945
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
263
D–189
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
2P Waterproof Type
2
1
90980–12194
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
264
D–190
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Waterproof Type
1
3
1
3
2
90980–10093
2
90980–10190
2 1
1
3
3 2
90980–10235
90980–10244
2
1
3
3 2 1
90980–10394
90980–10444
90980–10492
90980–10493
90980–10774
90980–10787
90980–10500
2 1
1
3
2
2
3
90980–10553
90980–10577
90980–10777
3
3
2
90980–10248
90980–10347
2
1
3 2 1
1
2
1
90980–10840
90980–10944
2 1
3
1
90980–11131
90980–10689
2
1
3
3
1
3
2
3
90980–10682
3
1
90980–11015
90980–10698
2 1
3
90980–11044
2
2
90980–11160
321
90980–11169
1
3
90980–11244
90980–11295
90980–11407
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
265
D–191
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
3P Waterproof Type
3
2
1
90980–11293
3
2
2 1
3
90980–11341
3
2
90980–11348
1
90980–11622
90980–12131
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
266
1
3
2
1
90980–11607
D–192
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Waterproof Type
2
1
4
3
90980–10094
2 1
4
90980–10139
2
2
1
4
3
90980–10475
2 1
4 3
90980–10662
2 1
4 3
90980–10941
2
4
1
3
90980–11063
90980–11064
3
2 1
4 3
90980–10202
1
3
90980–10217
1
2 1
4 3
1 2
90980–10510
90980–11076
2 1
4
2
4
3
90980–10749
2
1
4
3
90980–10989
2
1
4
3
90980–11122
2
1
4
3
90980–10590
90980–10648
2 1
4 3
2 1
90980–10751
90980–10768
2
4
1
3
90980–11027
2 1
4 3
90980–11138
4 3
90980–10868
2
1
4
3
90980–11035
2
4
1
3
90980–11177
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
267
D–193
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
4P Waterproof Type
2 1
4 3
2 1
4 3
90980–11262
90980–11328
90980–11268
2
4
1
3
90980–11929
2
4
90980–11287
4 3
90980–12177
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
268
1
3
2 1
4 3
90980–11291
D–194
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
5P Waterproof Type
3
2
5
1
4
2
5
1
4
3
90980–10161
90980–10392
3 2 1
2 1
5
4
5 4 3
54321
90980–10557
90980–10570
3 2 1
5
4
90980–10709
90980–10945
90980–11021
2
1
5 4 3
3 2 1
5 4 3 2 1
90980–11181
90980–11412
90980–11598
5 4
54 321
90980–10642
3
2
5
1
4
90980–11078
1
3
5
2
4
90980–11689
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
269
D–195
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
6P, 7P Waterproof Type
6 5 4
3 2 1
6 5 4
90980–10194
90980–10477
3 2 1
6 5 4
3 2 1
6 5 4
90980–10987
90980–11033
3 2 1
3
2
1
3
6
5
4
6
90980–11267
2
5
3
2
1
6
5
4
90980–10596
3
6
2
5
90980–11289
1
6
5
4
90980–10650
90980–10984
3
2
1
6
5
4
90980–11196
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2 1
5 4 3
7 6
90980–10627
90980–10930
1
4
2
90980–11193
3 2 1
7 6 5 4
90980–11171
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
270
1
4
3
D–196
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE
8P, 9P Waterproof Type
2
5
8
1
4 3
7 6
90980–10204
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
90980–10890
4
8
3
7
2
6
1
5
2
5
8
6
1
4
7
90980–10894
2
5
8
90980–10896
3
3
6
1
4
7
90980–11241
90980–11460
987654321
3 2 1
6 5 4
9 8 7
90980–10379
90980–10677
90980–10775
987654321
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
90980–10826
90980–11191
3
2 1
6
5 4
9
8 7
Wire Harness Repair Manual (RM1022E)
271
D–197
TABLE OF HOUSING SHAPE